N-14 1 dn14.htm COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST Columbia Funds Series Trust
Table of Contents

 

 

 

AS FILED ELECTRONICALLY WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON NOVEMBER 4, 2010

SECURITIES ACT FILE NO. 333-            

 

 

 

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM N-14

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

UNDER

THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933    x        
Pre-Effective Amendment No.    ¨        
Post-Effective Amendment No.    ¨        

 

 

COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Charter)

 

 

One Financial Center

Boston, Massachusetts 02111

(Address of Principal Executive Offices) (Zip Code)

(800) 321-7854

(Registrant’s Area Code and Telephone Number)

Scott R. Plummer, Esq.

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC

100 Federal Street

Boston, Massachusetts 02110

(Name and Address of Agent for Service)

 

 

With a copy to:

Brian D. McCabe, Esq.

Ropes & Gray LLP

Prudential Tower

800 Boylston Street

Boston, Massachusetts 02199

 

 

TITLE OF SECURITIES BEING REGISTERED:

Class A, Class B, Class C, Class I, Class R4 and Class W shares of the Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund series of the Registrant.

Class A, Class C and Class Z shares of the Columbia Large Cap Core Fund series of the Registrant.

Approximate Date of Proposed Public Offering: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

No filing fee is required because an indefinite number of shares have previously been registered pursuant to Rule 24f-2 under the Investment Company Act of 1940.

It is proposed that this filing will become effective on December 6, 2010 pursuant to Rule 488 under the Securities Act of 1933.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

Seligman Capital Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

Seligman Growth Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

COMBINED PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS

[], 2010

This is a brief overview of the reorganization and certain other actions proposed for your fund. We encourage you to read the full text of the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus.

Q: Why am I being asked to vote?

Funds are required to obtain shareholder approval for certain kinds of changes, like the reorganizations proposed in the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus. As a shareholder of one of the above-listed funds, you are being asked to vote on a reorganization involving your fund. In addition, the directors of those funds have nominated candidates for election or re-election as directors. Shareholders of those funds are entitled to vote in these elections. Certain of the funds listed above are also being asked to vote on an amendment to the Articles of Incorporation of the corporation of which their fund is a series in order to increase the maximum permissible number of directors from fifteen to twenty so that each of the candidates nominated by the directors, if elected, can serve on the applicable Board of Directors (the “Board”).

Q: What is a fund reorganization?

A fund reorganization involves one fund transferring all of its assets and liabilities to another fund in exchange for shares of such fund. Once completed, shareholders of the selling fund will hold shares of the buying fund.

Q: Is my vote important?

Absolutely! While the Board of each fund listed above has reviewed the proposed reorganizations and, as applicable, the proposed amendments, and recommends that you approve them, these proposals generally cannot go forward without the approval of shareholders. Similarly, while the Board of each fund has nominated candidates for director, you have the right to vote to elect the directors that oversee your fund. Until a fund is sure that a quorum has been reached, it will continue to contact shareholders asking them to vote.

Q: On what am I being asked to vote?

Shareholders are being asked to vote on the reorganization (a “Reorganization”) of one or more funds (each a “Selling Fund” and together, the “Selling Funds”) into other corresponding funds (each a “Buying Fund” and together, the “Buying Funds”), as noted in the table below:

 

Selling Fund

 

Buying Fund

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund   Columbia Contrarian Core Fund
Seligman Capital Fund   Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund
RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund   Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I
Seligman Growth Fund   Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund
RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund   Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

If the Reorganization of your Selling Fund is approved by shareholders and the other closing conditions are met, your shares of the Selling Fund will, in effect, be converted into shares of a corresponding class of the corresponding Buying Fund with the same aggregate net asset value as that of your Selling Fund shares at the time of the Reorganization. (Selling Funds and Buying Funds are referred to individually or collectively as a “Fund” or the “Funds.”) While the aggregate net asset value of your shares will not change as a result of the Reorganization, the number of shares you hold may differ based on each Fund’s net asset value.


Table of Contents

 

In addition, shareholders of each of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund are being asked to vote to amend such Fund’s Articles of Incorporation to increase the maximum number of directors from fifteen to twenty and shareholders of each Selling Fund (collectively, the “Board Election Funds”) are being asked to vote for the election or re-election of sixteen nominees for election as directors of those Funds.

We encourage you to read the full text of the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus to obtain a more detailed understanding of the issues relating to each proposed Reorganization and, as applicable, to the proposed amendments to the Articles of Incorporation of certain Funds and/or election or re-election of nominees as directors to your Fund’s Board.

Q: Why are the Reorganizations being proposed?

On May 1, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly known as RiverSource Investments, LLC), the Funds’ investment manager (“Columbia Management”), acquired the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC and certain of its affiliated companies from Bank of America, N.A. (the “Transaction”). In connection with the Transaction, Columbia Management became the investment manager of the Columbia-branded funds (the “Columbia Fund Complex”), in addition to the funds that were then branded as RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds (the “RiverSource Fund Complex” and, together with the Columbia Fund Complex, the “Combined Fund Complex”).

The proposed Reorganizations are among the reorganizations recommended by Columbia Management following the Transaction. Columbia Management’s overall goal in proposing the reorganizations is twofold. First, by combining Columbia-, RiverSource-, Seligman- and Threadneedle-branded funds with generally similar investment objectives, strategies and policies, each combined investment portfolio will be larger, which tends to lead to greater efficiency. Second, by streamlining the product offering of the Combined Fund Complex, management, administration, distribution and other resources can be focused more effectively on a smaller group of funds. The Reorganization of each Selling Fund into the corresponding Buying Fund will enable shareholders of each Selling Fund to invest in a larger, potentially more efficient portfolio while continuing to pursue a similar investment strategy.

Q: Will there be any changes to the options or services associated with my account as a result of the mergers?

Account-level features and options such as dividend distributions, dividend diversification, automatic investment plans, systematic withdrawals and dollar cost averaging will automatically carry over from accounts in each Selling Fund to accounts in the corresponding Buying Fund.

Q: Are there costs or tax consequences of the Reorganizations?

You will not pay any sales charge in connection with the Reorganizations. Reorganization costs will be allocated to each Fund only to the extent they are expected to be offset by the anticipated reduction in expenses borne by the Fund’s shareholders during the first year following the Reorganization. Each Reorganization is expected to be tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Accordingly, no gain or loss is expected to be recognized by the Selling Fund or its shareholders as a direct result of a Reorganization. A portion, which may be substantial, of the portfolio assets of a Buying or Selling Fund may be sold before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. Such sales will result in such Fund incurring transaction costs and may result in a taxable distribution of gains to shareholders.

Q: If approved, when will the Reorganizations happen?

The Reorganizations will take place as soon as practicable following shareholder approval, and are expected to close before the end of the second quarter of 2011.

Q: Why have the Boards of the Selling Funds nominated candidates for election to those Boards?

Following the Transaction, described above, the boards of directors/trustees of the RiverSource Fund Complex (the “Columbia RiverSource Board”) and the boards of trustees of the Columbia Fund Complex had ongoing discussions regarding a potential consolidated board of directors/trustees to oversee all or a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. In September 2010, these discussions culminated in an agreement between the Columbia RiverSource Board and the

 

-2-


Table of Contents

current board of trustees of certain of the trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex (the “Columbia Nations Board”) to have a consolidated board of directors/trustees for a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. Specifically, they agreed that the RiverSource Fund Complex and the portion of the Columbia Fund Complex overseen by the Columbia Nations Board should be overseen by a consolidated board of directors/trustees. In this regard, the Columbia Nations Board and the Columbia RiverSource Board each determined that the consolidation would enhance the oversight of a larger fund family and should achieve cost efficiencies for fund shareholders.

In order to effect the consolidation, the Governance Committees of the Columbia Nations Board and the Columbia RiverSource Board, along with each full Board, have nominated individuals listed under Proposal 6 of the combined proxy statement/prospectus for election to the Columbia Nations Board and the Columbia RiverSource Boards, each to hold office for an indefinite term. Information about each nominee is set forth in this combined proxy statement/prospectus under Proposal 6.

Q: Why have the Boards of certain Funds proposed amendments to the Funds’ Articles of Incorporation?

The Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund each include a provision that limits board size to 15 directors. To accommodate the proposed 16-person board of directors/trustees described above, these Funds’ Articles of Incorporation must be amended to increase the maximum permissible number of directors, which requires shareholder approval.

Q: How does my Board recommend that I vote?

After careful consideration, your Board recommends that you vote FOR the Reorganization of your Selling Fund, FOR the proposed amendments to the Articles of Incorporation of your Fund, if applicable, and FOR each nominee for election as director of your Fund.

Q: How can I vote?

You can vote in one of four ways:

 

 

By telephone ([[phone number]])

 

 

By internet ([[internet url]])

 

 

By mail (using the enclosed postage prepaid envelope)

 

 

In person at the shareholder meeting scheduled to occur in [[XXXX location]] on [[MM/DD/YY]]

The deadline for voting by telephone or internet is [[MM/DD/YY]]. We encourage you to vote as soon as possible to avoid the cost of additional solicitation efforts. Please refer to the enclosed proxy card for instructions for voting by telephone, internet or mail.

Q: Will I be notified of the results of the vote?

Please check www.columbiamanagement.com for updated information on the proposals described in the enclosed proxy statement/prospectus including voting results. The final voting results for each proposal also will be included in each fund’s next report to shareholders following the special shareholder Meeting.

Q: Whom should I call if I have questions?

If you have questions about any of the proposals described in the combined proxy statement/prospectus or about voting procedures, please call the Selling Funds’ proxy solicitor, Computershare Fund Services, toll free at (800) 708-7953.

 

-3-


Table of Contents

 

NOTICE OF A JOINT SPECIAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS

 

RiverSource Managers Series, Inc.

  RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc.

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.  

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

Seligman Capital Fund

  Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.
 

Seligman Growth Fund

To be held [], 2011

A Joint Special Meeting of Shareholders (the “Meeting”) of each of the Funds listed above (each a “Selling Fund”) will be held at [] [a.m./p.m.] on [] 2011, at [] in the [] room on the [] floor. At the Meeting, shareholders will consider the following proposal with respect to their Selling Fund:

 

1. To approve the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “Agreement”) by and among RiverSource Managers Series, Inc., on behalf of its RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund series, Seligman Capital Fund, Inc., on behalf of its Seligman Capital Fund series, RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc., on behalf of its RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund series, Seligman Growth Fund, Inc., on behalf of its Seligman Growth Fund series, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, pursuant to which each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the corresponding buying fund, as indicated below (each a “Buying Fund”), in exchange for shares of a corresponding class of the Buying Fund and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

Shareholders of each Selling Fund will vote separately on the relevant proposal, as shown below.

 

Selling Fund

  

Buying Fund

   Proposal #
RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund    Columbia Contrarian Core Fund    1
Seligman Capital Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund    2
RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund    Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I    3
Seligman Growth Fund    Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund    4
RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund    5

 

   For Shareholders of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund only, approval of the Agreement also will constitute approval of an amendment to the Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Managers Series, Inc., and for RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund only, approval of the Agreement also will constitute approval of an amendment to the Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc., to provide that such Selling Fund be acquired by the corresponding Buying Fund.

 

2. Each of Selling Fund also will vote to elect certain nominees as directors (Proposal 6).

 

3. At the Meeting, shareholders of each of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund also will vote to approve proposed amendments to the Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc. and RiverSource Managers Series, Inc. (Proposal 7).

Shareholders of each Selling Fund will vote on Proposals 6 and 7, as applicable, together as a single class with shareholders of each other series, if any, of the corporation of which such Fund is a series. The name of the corporation of which each Selling Fund is a series is indicated in bold at the beginning of this notice.

Please take some time to read the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus. It discusses these proposals in more detail. If you were a shareholder on December 17, 2010, you may vote at the Meeting or at any adjournment or postponement of the Meeting. You are welcome to attend the Meeting in person. If you cannot attend in person, please vote by mail, telephone or internet. Just follow


Table of Contents

the instructions on the enclosed proxy card. If you have questions, please call the Selling Funds’ proxy solicitor toll free at []. It is important that you vote. The Board of Directors of each Selling Fund recommends that you vote FOR its Reorganization and, if applicable, FOR the amendment of such Fund’s Articles of Incorporation, and FOR each nominee for director.

By order of the Boards of Directors

LOGO

Scott R. Plummer, Secretary

[], 2010

 

-2-


Table of Contents

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

Seligman Capital Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

Seligman Growth Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

COMBINED PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS

Dated [], 2010

This document is a proxy statement for each Selling Fund (as defined below) and a prospectus for each Buying Fund (as defined below). The address and telephone number of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund is c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, and 800.345.6611. This combined proxy statement/prospectus and the enclosed proxy card were first mailed to shareholders of each Selling Fund beginning on or about January [], 2011. This combined proxy statement/prospectus contains information you should know before voting on the following proposals with respect to your Selling Fund, as indicated below:

 

Proposal

  

To be voted on by
shareholders of:

1.      To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among RiverSource Managers Series, Inc., on behalf of its RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Contrarian Core Fund series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

 

Selling Fund

          Buying Fund

Class A

   g         Class A

Class B

   g         Class B

Class C

   g         Class C

Class I

   g         Class I

Class R4

   g         Class R4

 

2.      To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among Seligman Capital Fund, Inc., on behalf of its Seligman Capital Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   Seligman Capital Fund

 

Selling Fund

          Buying Fund

Class A

   g         Class A

Class B

   g         Class B

Class C

   g         Class C

Class I

   g         Class I

Class R*

   g         Class R

Class R5

   g         Class R5

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Capital Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.


Table of Contents

 

Proposal

  

To be voted on by
shareholders of:

3.      To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among RiverSource Dimensions Series Inc., on behalf of its RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

 

Selling Fund

          Buying Fund

Class A

   g         Class A

Class B

   g         Class B

Class C

   g         Class C

Class I

   g         Class I

Class R*

   g         Class R

 

* Class R shares of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

 

4.      To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among Seligman Growth Fund, Inc., on behalf of its Seligman Growth Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   Seligman Growth Fund

 

Selling Fund

          Buying Fund

Class A

   g         Class A

Class B

   g         Class B

Class C

   g         Class C

Class I

   g         Class I

Class R*

   g         Class R

Class R4

   g         Class R4

Class R5

   g         Class R5

 

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Growth Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

 

5.      To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc., on behalf of its RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust, on behalf of its Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as

   RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

 

-2-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal

  

To be voted on by
shareholders of:

indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

  

 

Selling Fund

          Buying Fund

Class A

   g         Class A

Class B

   g         Class B

Class C

   g         Class C

Class I

   g         Class I

Class R4

   g         Class R4

Class W

   g         Class W

 

6.       To elect certain nominees as directors.

   RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, Seligman Capital Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, Seligman Growth Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

 

7.       To approve proposed amendments to the Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc. RiverSource Managers Series, Inc. and RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc.

   RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

The proposals will be considered by shareholders who owned shares of the Selling Funds on December 17, 2010 at a joint special meeting of shareholders (the “Meeting”) that will be held at [] [[a.m./p.m.]] on [], 2011, at [] in the [] room on the [] floor. Each of the Selling Funds and the Buying Funds (each a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”) is a registered open-end management investment company (or a series thereof). Please read this combined proxy statement/prospectus and keep it for future reference.

Although the Board of Directors (the “Board”) of each Selling Fund* recommends that shareholders approve the reorganization of the Selling Fund into the corresponding Buying Fund (each a “Reorganization”), the Reorganization of each Selling Fund is not conditioned upon the Reorganization of any other Selling Fund. Accordingly, if shareholders of one Selling Fund approve its Reorganization, but shareholders of a second Selling Fund do not approve the second Selling Fund’s Reorganization, it is expected that the Reorganization of the first Selling Fund will take place as described in this combined proxy statement/prospectus. If shareholders of any Selling Fund fail to approve its Reorganization, the Board of such Selling Fund will consider what other actions, if any, may be appropriate.

The outcome of Proposal 7 will not be affected by the outcome of any other proposal. However, shareholders of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund will vote together as a single class with the shareholders of the other series of the corporation of which that Fund is a series. Thus, the outcome of Proposal 7 will depend in part on the votes of shareholders of those other series, which are being solicited separately.

 

-3-


Table of Contents

 

With respect to RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, the outcome of Proposal 6 is contingent on the outcome of Proposal 7 to the extent that if shareholders of the corporations of which these Funds are series elect all 16 Nominees but do not approve the proposed amendment to these corporations’ Articles of Incorporation, then Nominee William F. Truscott will not continue as a director of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund.

The Reorganizations of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund will only be effected if shareholders of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, respectively, approve at their upcoming shareholder meeting the proposed investment management services agreement that was approved by their Boards in September 2010.

Shareholders of each Selling Fund will vote together as a single class with the shareholders of the other series of the corporation of which that Fund is a series, if any. Thus, the outcome of Proposal 7 will depend in part on the votes of shareholders of those other series, which are being solicited separately.

 

* References to the Board of a Fund refer to the Board of the corporation of which the Fund is a series.

How Each Reorganization Will Work

 

 

Each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of such Buying Fund (“Reorganization Shares”) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the Selling Fund’s liabilities.

 

 

Each Buying Fund will issue Reorganization Shares with an aggregate net asset value equal to the aggregate value of the assets that it receives from the corresponding Selling Fund, less the liabilities it assumes from the corresponding Selling Fund. Each class of Reorganization Shares will be distributed to the shareholders of the corresponding class of the Selling Fund in liquidation of the Selling Fund in proportion to their holdings in such class of the Selling Fund. For example, holders of Class A shares of a Selling Fund will receive Class A shares of the corresponding Buying Fund with the same aggregate net asset value as their Selling Fund Class A shares at the time of the Reorganization. You will not pay any sales charge in connection with the receipt or distribution of Reorganization Shares. If you already have a Buying Fund account with exactly the same registration as your Selling Fund account, your Reorganization Shares typically will be added to that account.

 

 

Reorganization costs will be allocated to each Fund only to the extent they are expected to be offset by the anticipated reduction in expenses borne by the Fund’s shareholders during the first year following the Reorganization. Each Reorganization is expected to be tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Accordingly, no gain or loss is expected to be recognized by the Selling Fund or its shareholders as a direct result of a Reorganization. A portion, which may be substantial, of the portfolio assets of a Selling Fund may be sold before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. Such sales will result in such Fund incurring transaction costs and may result in a taxable distribution of gains to shareholders.

Where to Get More Information

The following documents have been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and are incorporated into this combined proxy statement/prospectus by reference:

 

 

The Statement of Additional Information of the Buying Funds relating to the Reorganizations (the “Merger SAI”), dated [], 2010;

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

 

 

the prospectus of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund dated July 30, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, dated November 29, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund for the year ended May 31, 2010;

 

-4-


Table of Contents

 

Seligman Capital Fund

 

 

the prospectus of Seligman Capital Fund, dated March 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Seligman Capital Fund, dated November 29, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Seligman Capital Fund for the year ended December 31, 2009, and the unaudited financial statements included in the Semiannual Report to Shareholders of Seligman Capital Fund for the period ended June 30, 2010;

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

 

 

the prospectus of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, dated September 27, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, dated November 29, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund for the year ended July 31, 2010;

Seligman Growth Fund

 

 

the prospectus of Seligman Growth Fund, dated March 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Seligman Growth Fund, dated November 29, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Seligman Growth Fund for the year ended December 31, 2009, and the unaudited financial statements included in the Semiannual Report to Shareholders of Seligman Growth Fund for the period ended June 30, 2010;

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

 

 

the prospectus of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, dated September 27, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, dated November 29, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund for the year ended July 31, 2010;

For a free copy of any of the documents listed above and/or to ask questions about this combined proxy statement/prospectus, please call your Selling Fund’s proxy solicitor toll free at [].

Each of the Funds is subject to the information requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”), and files reports, proxy materials and other information with the SEC. These reports, proxy materials and other information can be inspected and copied at the Public Reference Room maintained by the SEC. Copies may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request at publicinfo@sec.gov, or by writing to the Public Reference Branch of the SEC, Office of Consumer Affairs and Information Services, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549-0102. In addition, copies of these documents may be viewed online or downloaded from the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

Please note that investments in the Funds are not bank deposits, are not federally insured, are not guaranteed by any bank or government agency and may lose value. There is no assurance that any Fund will achieve its investment objectives.

As with all open-end mutual funds, the SEC has not approved or disapproved these securities or passed on the adequacy of this combined proxy statement/prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 

-5-


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

Section A — Reorganization Proposals

     8   

Summary

     8   

How Each Reorganization Will Work

     8   

Tax Consequences

     8   

Fees and Expenses

     9   

Proposal 1 Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund.

     10   

Proposal 2 Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

     14   

Proposal 3 Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

     17   

Proposal 4 Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

     21   

Proposal 5 Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

     25   

Proposal 1 Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

     29   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     29   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     29   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     29   

Comparison of Fundamental Policies

     31   

Comparison of Non-fundamental Policies

     33   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     33   

Comparison of Performance

     35   

Proposal 2 Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

     39   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     39   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     39   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     39   

Comparison of Fundamental Policies

     41   

Comparison of Non-fundamental Policies

     43   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     43   

Comparison of Performance

     46   

Proposal 3 Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

     50   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     50   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     50   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     50   

Comparison of Fundamental Policies

     51   

Comparison of Non-fundamental Policies

     53   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     54   

Comparison of Performance

     55   

Proposal 4 Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

     59   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     59   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     59   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     59   

Comparison of Fundamental Policies

     61   

Comparison of Non-fundamental Policies

     62   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     63   

Comparison of Performance

     65   

Proposal 5 Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

     69   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     69   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     69   

 

-6-


Table of Contents

 

     Page

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

   69

Comparison of Fundamental Policies

   71

Comparison of Non-fundamental Policies

   72

Comparison of Principal Risks

   73

Comparison of Performance

   74

Additional Information about Each Reorganization

   78

Terms of the Reorganizations

   78

Conditions to Closing Each Reorganization

   78

Termination of the Agreement

   78

Tax Status of the Reorganizations

   79

Reasons for the Proposed Reorganizations and Board Deliberations

   82

Board Recommendation and Required Vote

   86

Section B — Board Proposals

   87

Proposal 6 — Election of Directors

   87

Information Regarding the Independent Nominees

   88

Information Regarding the Interested Nominees

   90

Nominees’ Beneficial Ownership of Shares of Each Fund

   91

Status of Current Directors/Trustees

   91

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

   92

Current Committees of the Columbia RiverSource Board

   93

Nominee Qualifications

   95

Procedures for Communications to the Columbia RiverSource Board

   97

Executive Officers of the Companies

   97

Remuneration for Directors/Trustees and Officers

   97

Required Vote and Recommendation

   98

Proposal 7 — Amending the Articles of Incorporation to Increase the Maximum Number of Board Members

   99

Section C — Proxy Voting and Shareholder Meeting Information

   101

Section D — Capitalization, Ownership of Fund Shares and Financial Highlights

   104

Capitalization of Selling Funds and Buying Funds

   104

Ownership of Selling Fund and Buying Fund Shares

   107

Financial Highlights of Buying Funds

   110

Exhibits

  

A. Costs of the Reorganizations

   A-1

B. Minnesota Business Corporation Act Sections 302A.471 and 302A.473

   B-1

C. Additional Information Applicable to the Buying Funds

   C-1

D. Comparison of Organizational Documents

   D-1

E. Share Ownership of Nominees

   E-1

F. Board Governance Committee Charter

   F-1

G. Executive Officer and Director Information

   G-1

H. Director/Trustee Compensation

   H-1

 

-7-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION A — REORGANIZATION PROPOSALS

The following information describes each proposed Reorganization.

SUMMARY

This combined proxy statement/prospectus is being used by each Selling Fund to solicit proxies to vote at a joint special meeting of shareholders. Shareholders of each Selling Fund will consider a proposal to approve the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “Agreement”) providing for the Reorganization of their Selling Fund into the corresponding Buying Fund.

The following is a summary. More complete information appears later in this combined proxy statement/prospectus. You should read the entire combined proxy statement/prospectus and the exhibits because they contain details that are not included in this summary.

How Each Reorganization Will Work

 

 

Each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for Reorganization Shares and the assumption by the corresponding Buying Fund of all of the Selling Fund’s liabilities.

 

 

Each Buying Fund will issue Reorganization Shares with an aggregate net asset value equal to the aggregate value of the assets that it receives from the corresponding Selling Fund, less the liabilities it assumes from the corresponding Selling Fund. Reorganization Shares of each class of each Buying Fund will be distributed to the shareholders of the corresponding class of the corresponding Selling Fund in proportion to their holdings of such class of such Selling Fund. For example, holders of Class A shares of a Selling Fund will receive Class A shares of the corresponding Buying Fund with the same aggregate net asset value as the aggregate net asset value of their Selling Fund Class A shares at the time of the Reorganization.

 

 

As part of the Reorganization of your Selling Fund, systematic transactions (such as bank authorizations and systematic payouts) currently set up for your Selling Fund account may be transferred to your new Buying Fund account. Please contact your financial intermediary for additional details.

 

 

No shareholders of any Selling Fund will pay any sales charge in connection with acquiring Reorganization Shares.

 

 

After a Reorganization is completed, Selling Fund shareholders will be shareholders of the corresponding Buying Fund, and the Selling Fund will be dissolved.

Tax Consequences

Each Reorganization is expected to be tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes and will not take place unless the Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund receive a satisfactory opinion of tax counsel substantially to the effect that it will be tax-free, as described in more detail in the section entitled “Tax Status of the Reorganizations.” Accordingly, no gain or loss is expected to be recognized by the Selling Fund or its shareholders as a direct result of a Reorganization. A portion, which may be substantial, of the portfolio assets of a Buying or Selling Fund may be sold before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. The actual tax effect of such sales will depend on the difference between the price at which such portfolio assets are sold and the tax basis in such assets of the Fund making the sale. Any capital gains recognized in those sales on a net basis, after reduction by any available capital losses, will be distributed to shareholders as capital gain dividends (to the extent of net realized long-term capital gains over net realized short-term capital losses) and/or ordinary dividends (to the extent of net realized short-term capital gains over net realized long-term capital losses) during or with respect to the year of sale, and such distributions will be taxable to shareholders. Additionally, because each Reorganization will end the tax year of the applicable Selling Fund, it will accelerate distributions to shareholders from the Selling Fund for its short tax year ending on the date of the Reorganization. Those tax year-end distributions will be taxable, and will include any distributable, but not previously distributed, capital gains resulting from portfolio turnover prior to consummation of the Reorganization. At any time prior to a Reorganization, a shareholder may redeem shares of a Selling Fund. This would likely result in the recognition of gain or loss by the shareholder for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If a shareholder holds Selling Fund shares in a non-taxable account, distributions and redemption proceeds with respect to those shares will not be taxable to the shareholder if those amounts remain in the non-taxable account.

The Selling Fund shareholders’ aggregate tax basis in the Reorganization Shares is expected to carry over from the shareholders’ Selling Fund shares, and the Selling Fund shareholders’ holding period in the Reorganization Shares is expected to include the shareholders’ holding period in the Selling Fund shares.

 

-8-


Table of Contents

 

For more information about the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganizations, see the section entitled “Tax Status of the Reorganizations.”

Fees and Expenses

The following tables describe the fees and expenses that you may pay if you buy and hold shares of a Fund.

Annual fund operating expense ratios are based on expenses incurred during each Fund’s most recently completed fiscal year adjusted to reflect current and expected fees, as more fully described below, and are expressed as a percentage (expense ratio) of the Fund’s average net assets during the period. Pro forma expense ratios shown are based on each Fund’s average net assets over the applicable Buying Fund’s most recently completed fiscal year. As of the date of this combined proxy statement/prospectus, each Fund’s net assets may be lower or higher than the Fund’s average net assets over such period. In general, a Fund’s annual operating expense ratios will increase as the Fund’s assets decrease and will decrease as the Fund’s assets increase. Accordingly, each Fund’s annual operating expense ratios, if adjusted based on net assets as of the date of this combined proxy statement/prospectus, could be higher or lower than those shown in the tables below. The commitment by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (“Columbia Management”) and its affiliates to waive fees and/or to reimburse expenses for the Buying Funds noted below may limit the effect that any decrease in such a Buying Fund’s net assets will have on its annual net operating expense ratios in the current fiscal year.

The fees and expenses below exclude one-time costs of the Reorganization. The costs of each Reorganization expected to be borne by each Fund are set forth in Exhibit A.

 

-9-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 1. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by less than $0.01 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Class I and Class R4 shares of the Selling Fund are not expected to benefit from expense savings as a result of the Reorganization, but they nevertheless will bear a proportionate share of any Reorganization expenses allocated to the Selling Fund.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R4  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R4  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A   

 

(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

 

-10-


Table of Contents

 

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment):

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R4  

Management fees(1)

     0.81     0.81     0.81     0.81     0.81

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.30     0.30     0.30     0.04     0.34
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.36     2.11     2.11     0.85     1.15

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(3)

     (0.17 )%      (0.17 )%      (0.17 )%      (0.09 )%      (0.09 )% 
                                        

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.19     1.94     1.94     0.76     1.06

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R4  

Management fees(4)

     0.77     0.77     0.77     0.77     0.77

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(5)

     0.18     0.18     0.18     0.08     0.38
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.20     1.95     1.95     0.85     1.15

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(6)

     (0.04 )%      (0.04 )%      (0.04 )%      (0.01 )%      (0.01 )% 
                                        

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.16     1.91     1.91     0.84     1.14

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R4  

Management fees(7)

     0.74     0.74     0.74     0.74     0.74

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(5)

     0.22     0.22     0.22     0.05     0.35
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.22     1.97     1.97     0.79     1.09

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(8)

     (0.05 )%      (0.05 )%      (0.05 )%      (0.01 )%      (0.01 )% 
                                        

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.16     1.91     1.91     0.78     1.08

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fees of 0.73%, a performance incentive adjustment of 0.02%, and an administration fee of 0.06%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010.
(3) Columbia Management and its affiliates have contractually agreed to waive certain fees and to reimburse certain expenses (other than acquired fund fees and expenses, if any) until July 31, 2011. These fees and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management. Any amounts waived will not be reimbursed by the Fund. Under this agreement, net fund expenses (excluding acquired fund fees and expenses, if any), before giving effect to any performance incentive adjustment (which increased the management fee by 0.02% for the most recent fiscal year), will not exceed 1.17% for Class A shares, 1.92% for Class B shares, 1.92% for Class C shares, 0.74% for Class I shares and 1.04% for Class R4 shares.
(4) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.71% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.77% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.70% and an administration fee of 0.067%).
(5) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.

 

-11-


Table of Contents
(6) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed, on an annualized basis, 1.16% for Class A shares, 1.91% for Class B shares, 1.91% for Class C shares, 0.84% for Class I shares, and 1.14% for Class R4 shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until January 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.
(7) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.68% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.74% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.67% and an administration fee of 0.067%).
(8) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed, on an annualized basis, 1.16% for Class A shares, 1.91% for Class B shares, 1.91% for Class C shares, 0.78% for Class I shares, and 1.08% for Class R4 shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until January 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may be modified or amended only with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions your costs would be:

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class A

   $ 689       $ 965       $ 1263       $ 2107   

Class B

   $ 697       $ 945       $ 1319       $ 2241   

Class C

   $ 297       $ 645       $ 1119       $ 2433   

Class I

   $ 78       $ 262       $ 463       $ 1045   

Class R4

   $ 108       $ 357       $ 625       $ 1394   
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)                            

Class A

   $ 686       $ 930       $ 1,193       $ 1,943   

Class B

   $ 694       $ 908       $ 1,248       $ 2,067   

Class C

   $ 294       $ 608       $ 1,048       $ 2,272   

Class I

   $ 86       $ 270       $ 470       $ 1,048   

Class R4

   $ 116       $ 364       $ 632       $ 1,397   
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)                            

Class A

   $ 686       $ 932       $ 1,197       $ 1,952   

Class B

   $ 694       $ 910       $ 1,253       $ 2,074   

Class C

   $ 294       $ 610       $ 1,053       $ 2,281   

Class I

   $ 80       $ 251       $ 438       $ 977   

Class R4

   $ 110       $ 346       $ 600       $ 1,328   

 

-12-


Table of Contents

 

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class B

   $ 197       $ 645       $ 1119       $ 2241   

Class C

   $ 197       $ 645       $ 1119       $ 2433   
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)                            

Class B

   $ 194       $ 608       $ 1,048       $ 2,067   

Class C

   $ 194       $ 608       $ 1,048       $ 2,272   
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)                            

Class B

   $ 194       $ 610       $ 1,053       $ 2,074   

Class C

   $ 194       $ 610       $ 1,053       $ 2,281   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio.

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value of the Fund’s  Portfolio

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   9%

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   131%

 

-13-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 2. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by less than $0.01 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

Seligman Capital Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R*      Class R5  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

     Class A        Class B        Class C        Class I         Class R         Class R5   

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower )

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A         N/A   

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Capital Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment):

 

Seligman Capital Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R*     Class R5  

Management fees(1)

     0.87     0.87     0.87     0.87     0.87     0.87

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.31     0.31     0.31     0.16     0.31     0.17
                                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.43     2.18     2.18     1.03     1.68     1.04

 

-14-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R     Class R5  

Management fees(3)

     0.79     0.79     0.79     0.79     0.79     0.79

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(4)

     0.19     0.19     0.19     0.05     0.19     0.06
                                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(5)

     1.23     1.98     1.98     0.84     1.48     0.85

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R     Class R5  

Management fees(6)

     0.78     0.78     0.78     0.78     0.78     0.78

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(4)

     0.19     0.19     0.19     0.05     0.19     0.06
                                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(5)

     1.22     1.97     1.97     0.83     1.47     0.84

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Capital Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.81% and an administration fee of 0.06%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010.
(3) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.73% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.78% (composed solely of an investment management services fee), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.22% for Class A shares, 1.97% for Class B shares, 1.97% for Class C shares, 0.83% for Class I shares, 1.47% for Class R shares and 0.84% for Class R5 shares.
(4) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(5) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.35% for Class A shares, 2.10% for Class B shares, 2.10% for Class C shares, 0.99% for Class I shares, 1.60% for Class R shares and 1.04% for Class R5 shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until December 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.
(6) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.72% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.77% (composed solely of an investment management services fee), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.21% for Class A shares, 1.96% for Class B shares, 1.96% for Class C shares, 0.82% for Class I shares, 1.46% for Class R shares and 0.83% for Class R5 shares.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions your costs would be:

 

Seligman Capital Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class A

   $ 712       $ 1,002       $ 1,313       $ 2,194   

Class B

   $ 721       $ 982       $ 1,370       $ 2,327   

Class C

   $ 321       $ 682       $ 1,170       $ 2,518   

Class I

   $ 105       $ 328       $ 570       $ 1,264   

Class R*

   $ 171       $ 530       $ 914       $ 1,992   

Class R5

   $ 106       $ 331       $ 575       $ 1,276   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

                           

Class A

   $ 689       $ 931       $ 1,192       $ 1,935   

Class B

   $ 697       $ 909       $ 1,247       $ 2,070   

Class C

   $ 297       $ 609       $ 1,047       $ 2,264   

Class I

   $ 82       $ 255       $ 444       $ 990   

Class R

   $ 147       $ 456       $ 787       $ 1,724   

Class R5

   $ 83       $ 259       $ 450       $ 1,002   

 

-15-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class A

   $ 688       $ 928       $ 1,187       $ 1,924   

Class B

   $ 696       $ 906       $ 1,242       $ 2,059   

Class C

   $ 296       $ 606       $ 1,042       $ 2,254   

Class I

   $ 81       $ 252       $ 439       $ 978   

Class R

   $ 146       $ 452       $ 782       $ 1,713   

Class R5

   $ 82       $ 255       $ 444       $ 990   

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Capital Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

Seligman Capital Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class B

   $ 221       $ 682       $ 1,170       $ 2,327   

Class C

   $ 221       $ 682       $ 1,170       $ 2,518   
Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)                            

Class B

   $ 197       $ 609       $ 1,047       $ 2,070   

Class C

   $ 197       $ 609       $ 1,047       $ 2,264   
Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)                            

Class B

   $ 196       $ 606       $ 1,042       $ 2,059   

Class C

   $ 196       $ 606       $ 1,042       $ 2,254   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value of the Fund’s  Portfolio

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

   139%

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   160%

 

-16-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 3. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by less than $0.01 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R*  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Current and Pro forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A   

 

* Class R shares of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

 

-17-


Table of Contents

 

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that are deducted from Fund assets):

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R*  

Management fees(1)

     0.82     0.82     0.82     0.82     0.82

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50

Other expenses(2)

     0.45     0.45     0.45     0.23     0.45

Acquired fund fees and expenses(3)

     0.17     0.17     0.17     0.17     0.17
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.69     2.44     2.44     1.22     1.94

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(4)

     (0.20 )%      (0.20 )%      (0.20 )%      (0.15 )%      (0.20 )% 
                                        

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.49     2.24     2.24     1.07     1.74

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R  

Management fees(5)

     0.83     0.83     0.83     0.83     0.83

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50

Other expenses(6)

     0.26     0.26     0.26     0.06     0.26
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses(7)

     1.34     2.09     2.09     0.89     1.59

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R  

Management fees(5)

     0.83     0.83     0.83     0.83     0.83

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50

Other expenses(6)

     0.26     0.26     0.26     0.06     0.26
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses(7)

     1.34     2.09     2.09     0.89     1.59

 

* Class R shares of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.85%, a performance incentive adjustment of -0.11%, and an administration fee of 0.08%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010.
(3) Acquired fund fees and expenses include fees and expenses associated with the Fund’s investments in other investment companies and/or pooled investment vehicles.
(4) Columbia Management and its affiliates have contractually agreed to waive certain fees and to reimburse certain expenses (other than acquired fund fees and expenses, if any) until September, 30 2011. These fees and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management. Any amounts waived will not be reimbursed by the Fund. Under this agreement, net fund expenses (excluding acquired fund fees and expenses, if any), before giving effect to any performance incentive adjustment (which decreased the management fee by 0.11% for the most recent fiscal year), will not exceed 1.43% for Class A shares, 2.18% for Class B shares, 2.18% for Class C shares, 1.01% for Class I shares, 1.68% for Class R shares.
(5) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.75% and an administration fee of 0.08%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.76% (composed solely of an investment management services fee), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.27% for Class A shares, 2.02% for Class B shares, 2.02% for Class C shares, 0.82% for Class I shares and 1.52% for Class R shares.
(6) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(7) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.37% for Class A shares, 2.12% for Class B shares, 2.12% for Class C shares, 0.97% for Class I shares, and 1.62% for Class R shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until October 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

 

-18-


Table of Contents

 

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions your costs would be:

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class A

   $ 718       $ 1,059       $ 1,423       $ 2,447   

Class B

   $ 727       $ 1,042       $ 1,483       $ 2,579   

Class C

   $ 327       $ 742       $ 1,283       $ 2,765   

Class I

   $ 109       $ 373       $ 657       $ 1,469   

Class R*

   $ 177       $ 590       $ 1,030       $ 2,253   
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)                            

Class A

   $ 704       $ 975       $ 1,267       $ 2,095   

Class B

   $ 712       $ 955       $ 1,324       $ 2,229   

Class C

   $ 312       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,421   

Class I

   $ 91       $ 284       $ 493       $ 1,096   

Class R

   $ 162       $ 502       $ 866       $ 1,889   
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)                            

Class A

   $ 704       $ 975       $ 1,267       $ 2,095   

Class B

   $ 712       $ 955       $ 1,324       $ 2,229   

Class C

   $ 312       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,421   

Class I

   $ 91       $ 284       $ 493       $ 1,096   

Class R

   $ 162       $ 502       $ 866       $ 1,889   

 

* Class R shares of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

-19-


Table of Contents

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class B

   $ 227       $ 742       $ 1,283       $ 2,579   

Class C

   $ 227       $ 742       $ 1,283       $ 2,765   
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)                            

Class B

   $ 212       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,229   

Class C

   $ 212       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,421   
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)                            

Class B

   $ 212       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,229   

Class C

   $ 212       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,421   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value of the Fund’s  Portfolio

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   114%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Buying Fund)

   30%

 

-20-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 4. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by less than $0.01 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Class A, Class B, Class C and Class R shares of Seligman Growth Fund are not expected to benefit from expense savings as a result of the Reorganization, but they nevertheless will bear a proportionate share of any Reorganization expenses allocated to Seligman Growth Fund.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

Seligman Growth Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R*      Class R4      Class R5  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R      Class R4      Class R5  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Growth Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

 

-21-


Table of Contents

 

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment) as a percentage of average daily net assets:

 

Seligman Growth Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R*     Class R4     Class R5  

Management fees(1)

     0.72     0.72     0.72     0.72     0.72     0.72     0.72

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.29     0.29     0.29     0.03     0.29     0.33     0.08
                                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.26     2.01     2.01     0.75     1.51     1.05     0.80

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(3)

     (0.05 )%      (0.05 )%      (0.05 )%      0.00     (0.05 )%      0.00     0.00
                                                        

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.21     1.96     1.96     0.75     1.46     1.05     0.80

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R     Class R4     Class R5  

Management fees(4)

     0.73     0.73     0.73     0.73     0.73     0.73     0.73

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(5)

     0.23     0.23     0.23     0.06     0.23     0.36     0.11
                                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses(6)

     1.21     1.96     1.96     0.79     1.46     1.09     0.84

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R     Class R4     Class R5  

Management fees(7)

     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.50     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(5)

     0.26     0.26     0.26     0.04     0.26     0.34     0.09
                                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses(8)

     1.18     1.93     1.93     0.71     1.50     1.03     0.78

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Growth Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.66% and an administration fee of 0.06%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010.
(3) Columbia Management and its affiliates have contractually agreed to waive certain fees and to reimburse certain expenses (other than acquired fund fees and expenses, if any) until Feb 28, 2011. These fees and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management. Any amounts waived will not be reimbursed by the Fund. Under this agreement, net fund expenses (excluding acquired fund fees and expenses, if any) will not exceed 1.21% for Class A shares, 1.96% for Class B shares, 1.96% for Class C shares, 0.77% for Class I shares, 1.46% for Class R2 shares, 1.07% for Class R4 shares, and 0.82% for Class R5 shares.
(4) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.67% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.57% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.52% and an administration fee of 0.05%), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.05% for Class A, 1.80% for Class B, 1.80% for Class C, 0.63% for Class I, 1.30% for Class R, 0.93% for Class R4, and 0.68% for Class R5.
(5) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(6) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.25% for Class A shares, 2.00% for Class B shares, 2.00% for Class C shares, 0.87% for Class I shares, 1.50% for Class R shares, 1.17% for Class R4 shares and 0.92% for Class R5 shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until January 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

 

-22-


Table of Contents
(7) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.62% and an administration fee of 0.05%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.53% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.48% and an administration fee of 0.05%), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.04% for Class A shares, 1.79% for Class B shares, 1.79% for Class C shares, 0.57% for Class I shares, 1.29% for Class R shares, 0.87% for Class R4 shares, and 0.62% for Class R5 shares.
(8) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.25% for Class A, 2.00% for Class B, 2.00% for Class C, 0.80% for Class I, 1.50% for Class R, 1.10% for Class R4 and 0.85% for Class R5. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until January 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions, your costs would be:

 

Seligman Growth Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class A

   $ 691       $ 947       $ 1,223       $ 2,011   

Class B

   $ 699       $ 926       $ 1,279       $ 2,145   

Class C

   $ 299       $ 626       $ 1,079       $ 2,338   

Class I

   $ 77       $ 240       $ 418       $ 934   

Class R*

   $ 149       $ 473       $ 820       $ 1,802   

Class R4

   $ 107       $ 334       $ 580       $ 1,287   

Class R5

   $ 82       $ 256       $ 445       $ 994   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 691       $ 937       $ 1,202       $ 1,957   

Class B

   $ 699       $ 915       $ 1,257       $ 2,091   

Class C

   $ 299       $ 615       $ 1,057       $ 2,285   

Class I

   $ 81       $ 252       $ 439       $ 978   

Class R

   $ 149       $ 462       $ 797       $ 1,746   

Class R4

   $ 111       $ 347       $ 601       $ 1,329   

Class R5

   $ 86       $ 268       $ 466       $ 1,037   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 688       $ 928       $ 1,187       $ 1,924   

Class B

   $ 696       $ 906       $ 1,242       $ 2,059   

Class C

   $ 296       $ 606       $ 1,042       $ 2,254   

Class I

   $ 73       $ 227       $ 395       $ 883   

Class R

   $ 146       $ 452       $ 782       $ 1,713   

Class R4

   $ 103       $ 322       $ 558       $ 1,236   

Class R5

   $ 78       $ 243       $ 422       $ 942   

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Growth Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

 

-23-


Table of Contents

 

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

Seligman Growth Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class B

   $ 199       $ 626       $ 1,079       $ 2,145   

Class C

   $ 199       $ 626       $ 1,079       $ 2,338   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 199       $ 615       $ 1,057       $ 2,091   

Class C

   $ 199       $ 615       $ 1,057       $ 2,285   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 196       $ 606       $ 1,042       $ 2,059   

Class C

   $ 196       $ 606       $ 1,042       $ 2,254   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value of the Fund’s  Portfolio

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

   142%

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   142%

 

-24-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 5. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by less than $0.01 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R4      Class W  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I      Class R4      Class W  

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A         N/A         N/A   

 

(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

 

-25-


Table of Contents

 

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment) as a percentage of average daily net assets:

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R4     Class W  

Management fees(1)

     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67     0.67

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00     0.25

Other expenses(2)

     0.42     0.42     0.42     0.12     0.42     0.42

Acquired fund fees and expenses(3)

     0.03     0.03     0.03     0.03     0.03     0.03
                                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.37     2.12     2.12     0.82     1.12     1.37

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(4)

     (0.04 )%      (0.04 )%      (0.04 )%      0.00     0.00     (0.04 )% 
                                                

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.33     2.08     2.08     0.82     1.12     1.33

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R4     Class W  

Management fees(5)

     0.71     0.71     0.71     0.71     0.71     0.71

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00     0.25

Other expenses(6)

     0.23     0.23     0.23     0.05     0.35     0.23
                                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(7)

     1.19     1.94     1.94     0.76     1.06     1.19

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

   Class A     Class B     Class C     Class I     Class R4     Class W  

Management fees(8)

     0.70     0.70     0.70     0.70     0.70     0.70

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00     0.25

Other expenses(6)

     0.21     0.21     0.21     0.02     0.32     0.21
                                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(9)

     1.16     1.91     1.91     0.72     1.02     1.16

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.70%, a performance incentive adjustment of -0.09%, and an administration fee of 0.06%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010.
(3) Acquired fund fees and expenses include fees and expenses associated with the Fund’s investments in other investment companies and/or pooled investment vehicles.
(4) Columbia Management and its affiliates have contractually agreed to waive certain fees and to reimburse certain expenses (other than acquired fund fees and expenses, if any) until Sept. 30, 2011. These fees and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management. Any amounts waived will not be reimbursed by the Fund. Under this agreement, net fund expenses (excluding acquired fund fees and expenses, if any), before giving effect to any performance incentive adjustment (which decreased the management fee by 0.09% for the most recent fiscal year), will not exceed 1.39% for Class A shares, 2.14% for Class B shares, 2.14% for Class C shares, 0.92% for Class I shares, 1.22% for Class R4 shares and 1.39% for Class W shares.
(5) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.66% and an administration fee of 0.05%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.70% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.53% and an administration fee of 0.17%) and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.18 for Class A, 1.93 for Class B, 1.93 for Class C, 0.75 for Class I, 1.05 for Class R4 and 1.18 for Class W.
(6) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agent fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(7) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.19% for Class A shares, 1.94% for Class B shares, 1.94% for Class C shares, 0.80% for Class I shares, 1.10% for R4 shares and 1.19% for Class W shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until June 30, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

 

-26-


Table of Contents

 

(8) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.65% and an administration fee of 0.05%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would be 0.71% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.53% and an administration fee of 0.17%).
(9) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.19% for Class A shares, 1.94% for Class B shares, 1.94% for Class C shares, 0.80% for Class I shares, 1.10% for R4 shares and 1.19% for Class W shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until June 30, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions, your costs would be:

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class A

   $ 703       $ 980       $ 1279       $ 2128   

Class B

   $ 711       $ 960       $ 1336       $ 2262   

Class C

   $ 311       $ 660       $ 1136       $ 2453   

Class I

   $ 84       $ 262       $ 456       $ 1018   

Class R4

   $ 114       $ 356       $ 618       $ 1368   

Class W

   $ 135       $ 430       $ 747       $ 1648   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 689       $ 931       $ 1,192       $ 1,935   

Class B

   $ 697       $ 909       $ 1,247       $ 2,264   

Class C

   $ 297       $ 609       $ 1,047       $ 2,264   

Class I

   $ 78       $ 243       $ 422       $ 942   

Class R4

   $ 108       $ 337       $ 585       $ 1,294   

Class W

   $ 121       $ 378       $ 654       $ 1,443   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 686       $ 922       $ 1,177       $ 1,903   

Class B

   $ 694       $ 900       $ 1,232       $ 2,038   

Class C

   $ 294       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,233   

Class I

   $ 74       $ 230       $ 401       $ 894   

Class R4

   $ 104       $ 325       $ 563       $ 1,248   

Class W

   $ 118       $ 368       $ 638       $ 1,409   

 

-27-


Table of Contents

 

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class B

   $ 211       $ 660       $ 1136       $ 2262   

Class C

   $ 211       $ 660       $ 1136       $ 2453   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 197       $ 609       $ 1,047       $ 2,070   

Class C

   $ 197       $ 609       $ 1,047       $ 2,264   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 194       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,038   

Class C

   $ 194       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,233   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value of the Fund’s  Portfolio

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

   107%

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund)

   56%

 

-28-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 1. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

   

Have Columbia Management as investment manager. For the Selling Fund, Davis Selected Advisers, L.P. (“Davis”) serves as subadviser. The Buying Fund is not subadvised.

 

   

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange. Please see Exhibit C for a description of these policies for the Buying Fund.

 

   

Are structured as series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Minnesota corporation and the Buying Fund is organized as series of a Massachusetts business trust. Please see Exhibit D to this combined proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Buying Fund and shareholders of the Selling Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital growth.

Buying Fund: Columbia Contrarian Core Fund seeks total return, consisting of long-term capital appreciation and current income.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that any Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed only with shareholder approval, while the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

The Selling Fund and the Buying Fund have similar principal investment strategies. Under normal market conditions, each Fund invests primarily in equity securities of U.S. companies. The Selling Fund primarily invests in equity securities of U.S. companies with market capitalizations of at least $5 billion at the time of the Fund’s investment, while the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets, including borrowings for investment purposes, in equity securities of U.S. companies with large market capitalizations generally over $2 billion. The Buying Fund’s 80% policy can be changed by the Board without shareholder approval on sixty days prior written notice. As part of its principal investment strategies, the Selling Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments, while the Buying Fund may only invest up to 20% of its net assets in foreign investments. The Buying Fund may also invest in derivatives as a principal investment strategy for hedging and non-hedging purposes, while the Selling Fund may invest in derivatives, but does not consider investment in derivatives part of its principal investment strategies.

 

-29-


Table of Contents

 

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

The Fund’s assets are primarily invested in equity securities of U.S. companies. Under normal market conditions, the Fund’s net assets will be invested primarily in companies with market capitalizations of at least $5 billion at the time of the Fund’s investment.   Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in common stocks. In addition, under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of U.S. companies that have large market capitalizations (generally over $2 billion) that Columbia Management believes have the potential for long-term growth and current income.
The Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments.   The Fund may invest up to 20% of its net assets in foreign securities. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.
  The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.
The Fund may invest in any economic sector and, at times, it may emphasize one or more particular sectors.  

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying investment opportunities and constructing the Buying Fund’s portfolio. Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

   

various measures of valuation, including price-to-cash flow, price-to-earnings, price-to-sales, and price-to-book value. Columbia Management believes that companies with lower valuations are generally more likely to provide opportunities for capital appreciation.

 

   

potential indicators of stock price appreciation, such as anticipated earnings growth, company restructuring, changes in management, business model changes, new product opportunities or anticipated improvements in macroeconomic factors.

 

   

the financial condition and management of a company, including its competitive position, the quality of its balance sheet and earnings, its future prospects and the potential for growth and stock price appreciation.

 

   

overall economic and market conditions.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target set by Columbia Management; if Columbia Management believes that there is deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

 

-30-


Table of Contents

 

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. A “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

Borrowing / Issuing Senior Securities   

The Fund will not borrow money, except for temporary purposes (not for leveraging or investment) in an amount not exceeding 331/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings) immediately after the borrowings.

 

The Fund will not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

   The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Commodities    The Fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the Fund from buying or selling options, futures contracts and foreign currency or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.
Diversification   

The Fund will not purchase more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of an issuer, except that up to 25% of the Fund’s assets may be invested without regard to this 10% limitation.

 

The Fund will not invest more than 5% of its total assets in securities of any company, government, or political subdivision thereof, except the limitation will not apply to investments in securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities, or other investment companies, and except that up to 25% of the Fund’s total assets may be invested without regard to this 5% limitation.

   The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, and any applicable exemptive relief.

 

-31-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

Industry Concentration    The Fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the SEC, this means that up to 25% of the Fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Lending    The Fund will not lend securities or participate in an interfund lending program if the total of all such loans would exceed 331/3% of the Fund’s total assets except this fundamental investment policy shall not prohibit the Fund from purchasing money market securities, loans, loan participation or other debt securities, or from entering into repurchase agreements.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Real Estate    The Fund will not buy or sell real estate, unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the Fund from investing in securities or other instruments backed by real estate or securities of companies engaged in the real estate business or real estate investment trusts. For purposes of this policy, real estate includes real estate limited partnerships.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except that the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.
Underwriting    The Fund will not act as an underwriter (sell securities for others). However, under the securities laws, the Fund may be deemed to be an underwriter when it purchases securities directly from the issuer and later resells them.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, (the “1933 Act”) except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.

 

-32-


Table of Contents

 

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies:

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    No more than 15% of the Fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.
Investments in Other Investment Companies    No stated policy.    The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.
Short Selling    The Fund will seek Board approval prior to utilizing short sales as an active part of investment strategy.    The Fund may not sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

 

Investment Strategy Risk – Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. There is no assurance that the Buying Fund will achieve its investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk (with respect to Davis, rather than Columbia Management).

 

-33-


Table of Contents

 

 

Market Risk – Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Growth Securities Risk – Because growth securities typically trade at a higher multiple of earnings than other types of securities, the market values of growth securities may be more sensitive to changes in current or expected earnings than the market values of other types of securities. In addition, growth securities, at times, may not perform as well as value securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is not subject to growth securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in growth securities.

 

 

Value Securities Risk – Value securities are securities of companies that may have experienced, for example, adverse business, industry or other developments or may be subject to special risks that have caused the securities to be out of favor and, in turn, potentially undervalued. The market value of a portfolio security may not meet Columbia Management’s future value assessment of that security, or may decline. There is also a risk that it may take longer than expected for the value of these investments to rise to the believed value. In addition, value securities, at times, may not perform as well as growth securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Derivatives Risk – Derivatives are financial contracts whose values are, for example, based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or bond), assets (such as a commodity like gold or a foreign currency), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Derivatives involve special risks and may result in losses or may limit the Buying Fund’s potential gain from favorable market movements. Derivative strategies often involve leverage, which may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing the Buying Fund to lose more money than it would have lost had it invested in the underlying security or other asset. The values of derivatives may move in unexpected ways, especially in unusual market conditions, and may result in increased volatility, among other consequences. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount of taxes payable by shareholders holding shares in a taxable account. Other risks arise from the Buying Fund’s potential inability to terminate or to sell derivative positions. A liquid secondary market may not always exist for the Buying Fund’s derivative positions at times when the Buying Fund might wish to terminate or to sell such positions. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid, and transactions in derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. The use of derivatives also involves the risks of mispricing or improper valuation and that changes in the value of the derivative may not correlate perfectly with the underlying security, asset, reference rate or index. The Buying Fund also may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to engage in derivative transactions when it is deemed favorable to do so, or at all. For more information on the risks of derivative investments and strategies, see the Merger SAI. The Selling Fund is not subject to derivatives risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in derivatives.

 

 

Foreign Securities Risk – Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-34-


Table of Contents

 

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. Class I shares of the Buying Fund are new and Class R4 shares of the Buying Fund have not yet commenced operations; accordingly, performance information for those classes is not shown. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable CDSC for Class B and Class C shares;

 

   

no sales charge for Class I and Class R4 shares; and

 

   

with the exception of Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

 

-35-


Table of Contents

 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

- 17.46%

  + 29.19%   + 10.99%   + 8.99%   + 14.45%   + 4.27%   - 39.81%   + 32.02%

2002

  2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +20.86% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -24.61% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +1.33%.

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+ 3.86%

  - 5.85%   - 24.97%   + 22.14%   + 5.73%   + 11.11%   + 14.37%   + 12.25%   - 35.61%   + 37.02%

2000

  2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +20.67% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -23.26% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

The returns shown include the returns of the Galaxy Growth & Income Fund, the predecessor to the Fund, for periods prior to December 9, 2002, the date on which the Class A shares were initially offered by the Fund.

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +2.19%.

 

-36-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

      1 year     5 years     Class A, B, C & R4 Since
Inception
(6/18/01)
    Class I  Since
Inception
(3/4/04)
 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund):

        

Class A

        

Return before taxes

     +24.44     -0.52     +1.33     N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions

     +24.02     -1.28     +0.85     N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +15.88     -0.54     +1.07     N/A   

Class B

        

Return before taxes

     +26.05     -0.44     +1.27     N/A   

Class C

        

Return before taxes

     +29.79     -0.12     +1.31     N/A   

Class I

        

Return before taxes

     +32.54     +1.04     N/A        +1.92

Class R4

        

Return before taxes

     +32.11     +0.92     +2.26     N/A   

S&P 500 Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expense or taxes)

     +26.46     +0.42     +0.97     +1.44

Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Index

     +28.15     +0.61     +0.54     +1.30

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

      1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund(1) (Buying Fund)

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +29.17     +3.47     +1.18

Return after taxes on distributions

     +29.07     +2.65     +0.46

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +19.08     +2.92     +0.87

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +30.99     +3.58     +1.01

Class C

      

 

-37-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

      1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund(1) (Buying Fund)

      

Return before taxes

     + 34.95     + 3.91     + 1.02

Russell 1000 Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses or taxes)

     + 28.43     + 0.79     - 0.49

 

(1) The returns shown include the returns of the Galaxy Growth & Income Fund, the predecessor to the Fund, for periods prior to December 9, 2002, the date on which the share classes were initially offered by the Fund.

 

-38-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 2. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

   

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

   

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights. Please see Exhibit C for a description of those policies for the Buying Fund.

 

   

Are structured as series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Maryland corporation, and the Buying Fund is organized as series of a Massachusetts business trust. Please see Exhibit D to this combined proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Buying Fund and shareholders of the Selling Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: Seligman Capital Fund seeks to provide shareholders with capital appreciation.

Buying Fund: Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund seeks significant capital appreciation by investing, under normal market conditions, at least 80% of its net assets (plus any borrowings for investment purposes) in stocks of companies with a market capitalization at the time of initial purchase, equal to or less than the largest stock in the Russell Midcap Index.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed only with shareholder approval, while the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

The Selling Fund and the Buying Fund have similar principal investment strategies. Under normal market conditions, the Selling Fund primarily invests in the common stock of medium-sized U.S. companies with market capitalizations at the time of purchase of between $1 billion and $15 billion, while the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of the companies in the Russell MidCap Index at the time of purchase.

As part of its principal investment strategies, the Selling Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments, while the Buying Fund may only invest up to 20% of its net assets in foreign investments. The Buying Fund may also invest in derivatives, as a principal investment strategy for hedging and non-hedging purposes, while the Selling Fund may invest in derivatives, but does not consider investment in derivatives part of its principal investment strategies. The Buying Fund may also invest in special situations such as initial public offerings, in companies involved in management changes, tender offers, mergers and other corporate restructurings and in companies developing new technologies.

 

-39-


Table of Contents

 

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

Seligman Capital Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

(Buying Fund)

The Fund invests primarily in the common stocks of medium-sized U.S. companies. The Fund defines medium-sized companies as those with market capitalizations at the time of purchase by the Fund of between $1 billion and $15 billion. The Fund’s Board of Directors may change the parameters by which “medium-sized companies” are defined if it concludes that such a change is appropriate.    Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets (which includes net assets plus any borrowings for investment purposes) in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of the companies in the Russell Mid Cap Index at the time of purchase (between $25 million and $15.8 billion as of November 30, 2009). The Fund invests primarily in common stocks of companies that Columbia Management believes have the potential for long-term, above average earnings growth. The Fund also may invest up to 20% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations outside the range of the Russell Midcap Index.
   The Fund’s policy regarding the 80% investment requirement of “net assets” (which includes net assets plus any borrowing for investment purposes) discussed above may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval as long as shareholders are given 60 days notice of the change.
The Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments.    The Fund may invest up to 20% of its net assets in foreign securities. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.
   The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.
   The Fund may invest in convertible securities, including preferred stock, warrants and debentures.
   The Fund may invest in special situations such as initial public offerings, in companies involved in management changes, tender offers, mergers and other corporate restructurings and in companies developing new technologies.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying investment opportunities and constructing the Buying Fund’s portfolio.

 

-40-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

   

overall economic and market conditions.

 

   

the financial condition and management of a company, including its competitive position, the quality of its balance sheet and earnings, its future prospects and the potential for growth and stock price appreciation.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target set by Columbia Management; if Columbia Management believes that there is deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

The Buying Fund’s investment strategy may involve the frequent trading of portfolio securities. This may cause the Buying Fund to incur higher transaction costs (which may adversely affect the Buying Fund’s performance) and may increase taxable distributions for shareholders.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. A “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

Borrowing / Issuing Senior Securities   

The Fund will not issue senior securities or borrow money, except as permitted under the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

 

The Fund will not purchase securities on margin except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

   The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Commodities    The Fund will not purchase or sell commodities or commodity contracts, except to the extent permissible under applicable law and interpretations, as they may be amended from time to time.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that it may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.

 

-41-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

Dealings with Directors and Officers   

The Fund will not deal with its directors or officers, or firms they are associated with, in the purchase or sale of securities of other issuers, except as broker.

 

The Fund will not purchase or hold the securities of any issuer, if to its knowledge, directors or officers of the fund individually owning beneficially more than 0.5% of the outstanding securities of that issuer own in the aggregate more than 5% of such securities.

   No stated policy.
Diversification    The Fund will not make any investment inconsistent with its classification as a diversified company under the 1940 Act.    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, and any applicable exemptive relief.
Industry Concentration    The Fund will not invest 25% or more of its total assets, at market value, in the securities of issuers in any particular industry, provided that this limitation shall exclude securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government or any of its agencies or instrumentalities.    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Lending    The Fund will not make loans, except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Real Estate    The Fund will not purchase or hold any real estate, except that the Fund may invest in securities secured by real estate or interests therein or issued by persons (other than real estate investment trusts) which deal in real estate or interests therein.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except that the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.
Repurchase Agreements    The Fund will not enter into repurchase agreements of more than one week’s duration if more than 10% of the Fund’s net assets would be so invested.    No stated policy.
Underwriting    The Fund will not underwrite the securities of other issuers, except insofar as the Fund may be deemed an underwriter under the 1933 Act, as amended, in disposing of a portfolio security or in connection with investments in other investment companies.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.

 

-42-


Table of Contents

 

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    No more than 15% of the Fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.
Investments in Other Investment Companies    No stated policy.    The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

-43-


Table of Contents

 

 

Investment Strategy Risk – Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Market Risk – Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Growth Securities Risk – Because growth securities typically trade at a higher multiple of earnings than other types of securities, the prices of growth securities may be more sensitive to changes in current or expected earnings than the prices of other types of securities. In addition, growth securities, at times, may not perform as well as value securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Smaller Company Securities Risk – Securities of small- or mid-capitalization companies (“smaller companies”) can, in certain circumstances, have a higher potential for gains than securities of large-capitalization companies but may also have more risk. For example, smaller companies may be more vulnerable to market downturns and adverse business or economic events than larger, more established companies because they may have more limited financial resources and business operations. These companies are also more likely than larger companies to have more limited product lines and operating histories and to depend on smaller management teams. Their securities may trade less frequently and in smaller volumes and may be less liquid and fluctuate more sharply in value than securities of larger companies. In addition, some smaller companies may not be widely followed by the investment community, which can lower the demand for their stocks. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Foreign Securities Risk – Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Derivatives Risk – Derivatives are financial contracts whose values are, for example, based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or bond), assets (such as a commodity like gold or a foreign currency), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Derivatives involve special risks and may result in losses or may limit the Buying Fund’s potential gain from favorable market movements. Derivative strategies often involve leverage, which may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing the Buying Fund to lose more money than it would have lost had it invested in the underlying security. The values of derivatives may move in unexpected ways, especially in unusual market conditions, and may result in increased volatility, among other consequences. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount of taxes payable by shareholders. Other risks arise from the Buying Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell derivative positions. A liquid secondary market may not always exist for the Buying Fund’s derivative positions at times when the Buying Fund might wish to terminate or to sell such positions. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not

 

-44-


Table of Contents
 

traded on an exchange) may be illiquid, and transactions in derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. The use of derivatives also involves the risks of mispricing or improper valuation and that changes in the value of the derivative may not correlate perfectly with the underlying security, asset, reference rate or index. The Buying Fund also may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to engage in derivative transactions when it is deemed favorable to do so, or at all. For more information on the risks of derivative investments and strategies, see the Merger SAI. The Selling Fund is not subject to derivatives risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in derivatives.

 

 

Convertible Securities Risk – Convertible securities are subject to the usual risks associated with debt securities, such as interest rate risk and credit risk. Convertible securities also react to changes in the value of the common stock into which they convert, and are thus subject to market risk. Because the value of a convertible security can be influenced by both interest rates and market movements, a convertible security generally is not as sensitive to interest rates as a similar debt security, and generally will not vary in value in response to other factors to the same extent as the underlying common stock. In the event of a liquidation of the issuing company, holders of convertible securities would typically be paid before the company’s common stockholders but after holders of any senior debt obligations of the company. The Buying Fund may be forced to convert a convertible security before it otherwise would choose to do so, which may decrease the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to convertible securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in convertible securities.

 

 

Currency Risk – Securities denominated in different currencies are subject to the risk that, for example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the U.S. dollar value of any securities held by the Buying Fund denominated in that currency. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Special Situations Risk – Securities of companies that are involved in an initial public offering or a major corporate event, such as a business consolidation or restructuring, may present special risk because of the high degree of uncertainty that can be associated with such events. Securities issued in initial public offerings often are issued by companies that are in the early stages of development, have a history of little or no revenues and may operate at a loss following the offering. It is possible that there will be no active trading market for the securities after the offering, and that the market price of the securities may be subject to significant and unpredictable fluctuations. Investing in special situations may have a magnified effect on the performance of funds with small amounts of assets. The Selling Fund is not subject to special situations risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in securities of companies involved in an initial public offering or a major corporate event.

 

 

Industry Sector Risk – At times, the Buying Fund may have a significant portion of its assets invested in securities of companies conducting business in the same industry or in a closely related group of industries within an economic sector. Companies in the same industry or sector may be similarly affected by economic or market events, making the Buying Fund more vulnerable to unfavorable developments in an industry or sector than funds that invest more broadly. The Selling Fund is not subject to industry sector risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in securities of companies conducting business in the same industry or in a closely related group of industries within an economic sector.

 

 

Frequent Trading Risk – Frequent trading of investments increases the possibility that the Buying Fund will realize taxable capital gains (including short-term capital gains, which are generally taxable at higher rates than long-term capital gains for federal income tax purposes), which could reduce the Buying Fund’s after-tax return. Frequent trading can also mean higher brokerage and other transaction costs, which could reduce the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to frequent trading risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its frequent trading of investments.

 

-45-


Table of Contents

 

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. Class I shares of the Buying Fund are new, Class R5 shares of the Buying Fund have not yet commenced operations and Class I shares of the Selling Fund are new; accordingly, performance information for those classes is not shown. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable CDSC for Class B and Class C shares;

 

   

no sales charge for Class R and Class R5 shares; and

 

   

with the exception of Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

 

-46-


Table of Contents

 

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+7.72%

  -15.05%   -33.32%   +37.71%   +8.15%   +11.52%   +5.45%   +15.75%   -48.44%   +49.81%

2000

  2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +26.26% (quarter ended December 31, 2001) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -29.58% (quarter ended September 30, 2001).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +12.00%.

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+13.84%

  -20.98%   -24.64%   +29.86%   +6.88%   +16.08%   +11.67%   +19.80%   -44.12%   43.52%

2000

  2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +28.60% (quarter ended March 31, 2000) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -27.29% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

Class A is a newer class of shares. Its performance includes returns of the Fund’s Class Z shares (the oldest existing Fund class) for periods prior to its inception. These returns have not been restated to reflect any differences in expenses, such as distribution and service (Rule 12b-1) fees between Class A and Class Z shares. If differences in expenses had been reflected, the returns shown for periods prior to the inception date of Class A shares would have been lower, since Class A shares are subject to a distribution and service (Rule 12b-1) fee. Class A shares were initially offered on November 1, 2002, and Class Z shares were initially offered on November 20, 1985.

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +13.32%.

 

-47-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years     Class R* Since  Inception
(4/30/03)
    Class R5 Since  Inception
(11/30/01)
 

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund):

          

Class A

          

Return before taxes

     +41.18     -0.18     -1.26     N/A        N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions

     +41.18     -0.18     -1.84     N/A        N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +26.77     -0.15     -1.25     N/A        N/A   

Class B

          

Return before taxes

     +43.68     -0.16     -1.42     N/A        N/A   

Class C

          

Return before taxes

     +47.63     +0.25     -1.41     N/A        N/A   

Class R*

          

Return before taxes

     +49.51     +0.82     N/A        +6.04     N/A   

Class R5

          

Return before taxes

     +50.86     +1.59     N/A        N/A        +1.07

Russell Midcap® Growth Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +46.29     +2.40     -0.52     +8.63     +4.23

Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Index (reflects no deduction for fees or taxes)

     +42.65     +3.35     -1.47     +8.56     +3.87

Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Average (reflects no deduction for fees or taxes)

     +40.73     +1.63     +0.11     +7.18     +3.28

 

* Class R shares were formerly named Class R2 shares.

 

-48-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)(1)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund):

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +35.29     +3.26     +1.00

Return after taxes on distributions

     +35.29     +2.38     -0.25

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +22.94     +2.70     +0.41

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +37.45     +3.37     +1.05

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +41.39     +3.70     +1.07

Class R

      

Return before taxes

     +43.15     +4.27     +1.49

Russell Midcap Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +40.48     +2.43     +4.98

Russell Midcap Growth Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +46.29     +2.40     -0.52

 

(1) Class A, Class B, Class C and Class R are newer classes of shares. Their performance information includes returns of the Fund’s Class Z shares (the oldest existing Fund class) for periods prior to their inception. The returns for Class C shares include the returns of Class B shares for periods prior to October 13, 2003, the date on which Class C shares were initially offered by the Fund. The returns shown for Class C shares also include the returns of the Class Z shares for periods prior to November 1, 2002, the date on which Class B shares were initially offered by the Fund. The returns for Class R shares include the returns of Class A shares for periods prior to January 23, 2006, the date on which Class R shares were initially offered by the Fund. The returns shown for Class R shares also include the returns of Class Z shares for periods prior to November 1, 2002, the date on which Class A shares were initially offered by the Fund. These returns have not been restated to reflect any differences in expenses such as distribution and service (Rule 12b-1) fees between Class Z shares and the newer classes of shares. If differences in expenses had been reflected, the returns shown for periods prior to the inception of the newer classes would have been lower. Class Z shares were initially offered on November 20, 1985.

 

-49-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 3. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

 

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

 

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights. Please see Exhibit C for a description of these policies for the Buying Fund.

 

 

Are structured as series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Minnesota corporation and the Buying Fund is organized as series of a Massachusetts business trust. Please see Exhibit D to this combined proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Buying Fund and shareholders of the Selling Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

 

Selling Fund: RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital growth.

 

Buying Fund: Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed only with shareholder approval, while the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

The Selling Fund and the Buying Fund have similar principal investment strategies. Under normal market conditions, each Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations that fall within the range of companies in the Russell 2000 Value Index at the time of purchase. As part of its principal strategies, the Selling Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments, while the Buying Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign investments.

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

(Buying Fund)

Under normal market conditions, at least 80% of the Fund’s net assets are invested in small capitalization equity securities. For these purposes, small capitalization equity securities are securities of companies with market capitalizations that fall within the range of companies that comprise the Russell 2000 Value Index at the time of investment. The market capitalization range and composition of the Russell 2000 Value Index is subject to change. Over time, the capitalizations of the companies in the Russell 2000 Value Index will change. As they do, the size of the companies in which the Fund invests  

Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of the companies in the Russell 2000 Value Index at the time of purchase (between $34 million and $2.3 billion as of August 31, 2010), that Columbia Management believes are undervalued.

 

The Fund’s policy regarding the 80% investment requirement of “net assets” (which includes net assets plus any borrowings for investment purposes) discussed above may

 

-50-


Table of Contents

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

(Buying Fund)

may change. As long as an investment continues to meet the Fund’s other investment criteria, the Fund may choose to continue to hold a stock even if the company’s market capitalization grows beyond the largest absolute market capitalization weighting held within the Russell 2000 Value Index or falls below the market capitalization of the smallest company held within the Index. The Fund will provide shareholders with at least 60 days’ written notice of any change in the 80% policy.   be changed by the Board without shareholder approval as long as shareholders are given 60 days notice of the change.
The Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments.   The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management, the Buying Fund’s investment manager, combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying value opportunities and constructing the Fund’s portfolio. Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

 

businesses that are believed to be fundamentally sound and undervalued due to investor indifference, investor misperception of company prospects, or other factors.

 

 

various measures of valuation, including price-to-cash flow, price-to-earnings, price-to-sales, and price-to-book value. Columbia Management believes that companies with lower valuations are generally more likely to provide opportunities for capital appreciation.

 

 

a company’s current operating margins relative to its historic range and future potential.

 

 

potential indicators of stock price appreciation, such as anticipated earnings growth, company restructuring, changes in management, business model changes, new product opportunities, or anticipated improvements in macroeconomic factors.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target set by Columbia Management; if Columbia Management believes that there has been deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. A “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

 

-51-


Table of Contents

 

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

(Buying Fund)

Borrowing / Issuing Senior Securities   

The Fund will not borrow money, except for temporary purposes (not for leveraging or investment) in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings) immediately after the borrowings.

 

The Fund will not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

   The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Commodities    The Fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the Fund from buying or selling options, futures contracts and foreign currency or from entering into forward currency contracts or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may, to the extent consistent with its investment objective, (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs; (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts; and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions, including, without limitation, forward currency contracts.
Diversification   

The Fund will not purchase more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of an issuer, except that up to 25% of the Fund’s assets may be invested without regard to this 10% limitation.

 

The Fund will not invest more than 5% of its total assets in securities of any company, government, or political subdivision thereof, except the limitation will not apply to investments in securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities, or other investment companies, and except that up to 25% of the Fund’s total assets may be invested without regard to this 5% limitation.

   The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.
Industry Concentration    The Fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the SEC, this means that up to 25% of the Fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

 

-52-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

(Buying Fund)

Lending    The Fund will not lend securities or participate in an interfund lending program if the total of all such loans would exceed 33 1/3% of the Fund’s total assets except this fundamental investment policy shall not prohibit the Fund from purchasing money market securities, loans, loan participation or other debt securities, or from entering into repurchase agreements.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Real Estate    The Fund will not buy or sell real estate, unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the Fund from investing in securities or other instruments backed by real estate or securities of companies engaged in the real estate business or real estate investment trusts. For purposes of this policy, real estate includes real estate limited partnerships.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.
Underwriting    The Fund will not act as an underwriter (sell securities for others). However, under the securities laws, the Fund may be deemed to be an underwriter when it purchases securities directly from the issuer and later resells them.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

(Buying Fund)

Foreign Securities    Up to 25% of the Fund’s net assets may be invested in foreign investments.    The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities.
Illiquid Securities    No more than 15% of the Fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.

 

-53-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

(Buying Fund)

Investments in Other Investment Companies    No stated policy.   

The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of other registered open-end investment companies or registered unit investment trusts in reliance on Sections 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940

Act.

Short Selling    The Fund will seek Board approval prior to utilizing short sales as an active part of investment strategy.    Sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

 

Investment Strategy Risk – Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Market Risk – Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-54-


Table of Contents

 

 

Value Securities Risk – Value securities are securities of companies that may have experienced, for example, adverse business, industry or other developments or may be subject to special risks that have caused the securities to be out of favor and, in turn, potentially undervalued. The market value of a portfolio security may not meet Columbia Management’s future value assessment of that security, or may decline. There is also a risk that it may take longer than expected for the value of these investments to rise to the believed value. In addition, value securities, at times, may not perform as well as growth securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this risk.

 

 

Smaller Company Securities Risk – Securities of small- or mid-capitalization companies (“smaller companies”) can, in certain circumstances, have a higher potential for gains than securities of large-capitalization companies but may also have more risk. For example, smaller companies may be more vulnerable to market downturns and adverse business or economic events than larger, more established companies because they may have more limited financial resources and business operations. These companies are also more likely than larger companies to have more limited product lines and operating histories and to depend on smaller management teams. Their securities may trade less frequently and in smaller volumes and may be less liquid and fluctuate more sharply in value than securities of larger companies. In addition, some smaller companies may not be widely followed by the investment community, which can lower the demand for their stocks. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Foreign Securities Risk – Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Industry Sector Risk – At times, the Buying Fund may have a significant portion of its assets invested in securities of companies conducting business in the same industry or in a closely related group of industries within an economic sector. Companies in the same industry or sector may be similarly affected by economic or market events, making the Buying Fund more vulnerable to unfavorable developments in an industry or sector than funds that invest more broadly. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

 

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

 

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

 

-55-


Table of Contents

 

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. Class I and Class R shares of the Buying Fund are new; accordingly, performance information for those classes is not shown. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

 

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

 

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable CDSC for Class B and Class C shares;

 

 

no sales charge for Class I and Class R shares; and

 

 

with the exception of Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-14.81%   -30.56%   +22.90%

2007

  2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +19.24% (quarter ended September 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -24.93% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +6.08%.

 

-56-


Table of Contents

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+18.96%

  +6.86%   -6.95%   +39.41%   +22.81%   +5.27%   +19.28%   -2.63%   -28.23%   +24.44%

2000

  2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +20.59% (quarter ended September 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -24.09% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +7.81%.

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   
      1 year     Classes A, B, C & I
Since Inception
(2/16/06)
    Class R(1)  Since Inception
(12/11/06)
 

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Selling Fund):

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +15.83     -7.51     N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions

     +15.58     -7.96     N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions

and sale of Fund shares

     +10.29     -6.48     N/A   

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +17.09     -7.52     N/A   

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +21.00     -6.83     N/A   

Class I

      

Return before taxes

     +23.48     -5.79     N/A   

Class R (1)

      

Return before taxes

     +22.29     N/A        -10.04

Russell 2000 Value Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +20.58     -3.24     -8.03

Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Index

     +33.00     -1.81     -5.16

 

(1) Class R shares were formerly named Class R2 shares. Past performance for Class R for the period prior to the beginning of operations for that class may be calculated based on the performance of Class B. The blended class performance will be adjusted to reflect differences in sales charges, but not differences in annual Fund operating expenses (for example, 12b-1 fees). The use of blended performance generally results in a presentation of higher performance for classes with higher operating expenses than those of the class with which they are blended, and a presentation of lower performance for classes with lower operating expenses than those of the class with which they are blended.

 

-57-


Table of Contents
Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   
      1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Buying Fund):

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +17.28     +0.58     +7.62

Return after taxes on distributions

     +17.19     -0.25     +6.38

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +11.35     +0.50     +6.33

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +18.52     +0.72     +7.44

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +22.49     +1.01     +7.44

Russell 2000 Value Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +17.74     -2.05     +6.01

 

-58-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 4. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

   

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

   

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights. Please see Exhibit C for a description of these policies for the Buying Fund.

 

   

Are structured as series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Maryland corporation and the Buying Fund is organized as series of a Massachusetts business trust. Please see Exhibit D to this combined proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Buying Fund and shareholders of the Selling Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: Seligman Growth Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital appreciation.

Buying Fund: Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed only with shareholder approval, while the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

The Selling Fund and the Buying Fund both focus their investments in large U.S. companies. The Selling Fund invests primarily in the common stock of large U.S. companies, selected for their growth prospects while the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of large capitalization companies, primarily common stocks and securities that can be converted into common stocks. The Selling Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments while the Buying Fund may invest only up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities. The Buying Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes. The Selling Fund may invest in derivatives, but does not consider investment in derivatives part of its principal investment strategies.

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

Seligman Growth Fund

(the Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

(the Buying Fund)

Generally, the Fund invests primarily in the common stock of large U.S. companies, selected for their growth prospects.   Under normal market conditions, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of large capitalization companies, primarily common stocks and securities that can be converted into common stocks. These companies generally have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell 1000 Growth Index at the time of purchase (between $939 million and $301.5 billion as of August 31, 2010). The Fund invests primarily in common stocks of companies that Columbia Management believes have the potential for long-term, above-average earnings growth. The Fund’s 80% policy may be changed without shareholder approval as long as shareholders are given 60 days notice of the change.

 

-59-


Table of Contents

 

Seligman Growth Fund

(the Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

(the Buying Fund)

The Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments.   The Fund may also invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.
 

The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments.

 

The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying investment opportunities and constructing the Buying Fund’s portfolio. Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

   

overall economic and market conditions.

 

   

the financial condition and management of a company, including its competitive position, the quality of its balance sheet and earnings, its future prospects, and the potential for growth and stock price appreciation.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target set by Columbia Management; if Columbia Management believes that there has been deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

The Buying Fund’s investment strategy may involve the frequent trading of portfolio securities. This may cause the Buying Fund to incur higher transaction costs (which may adversely affect the Buying Fund’s performance) and may increase the taxable distributions for shareholders.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

 

-60-


Table of Contents

 

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. A “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Seligman Growth Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

(Buying Fund)

Borrowing /

Issuing Senior Securities

  

The Fund will not issue senior securities or borrow money, except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

 

The Fund will not purchase securities on margin except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC rule or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

   The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Commodities    The Fund will not purchase or sell commodities or commodity contracts, except to the extent permissible under applicable law and interpretations, as they may be amended from time to time.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.
Dealings with Directors, Officers and Trustees    The Fund will not deal with its directors or officers, or firms they are associated with, in the purchase or sale of securities of other issuers, except as broker.    No fundamental policy.
Diversification    The Fund will not make any investment inconsistent with its classification as a diversified company under the 1940 Act.    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, and any applicable exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.
Industry Concentration    The Fund will not invest 25% or more of its total assets, at market value, in the securities of issuers in any particular industry, provided that this limitation shall exclude securities issued or    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same

 

-61-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

Seligman Growth Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

(Buying Fund)

   guaranteed by the U.S. government or any of its agencies or instrumentalities.    industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Lending    The Fund will not make loans, except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Real Estate    The Fund will not purchase or hold any real estate, except that the Fund may invest in securities secured by real estate or interests therein or issued by persons (other than real estate investment trusts) which deal in real estate or interests therein.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.
Underwriting    The Fund will not underwrite the securities of other issuers, except insofar as the Fund may be deemed an underwriter under the 1933 Act in disposing of a portfolio security or in connection with investments in other investment companies.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

 

-62-


Table of Contents

 

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    No more than 15% of the Fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.
Investments to Control    No stated policy.    The Fund may not purchase securities of companies for the purpose of exercising control.
Investment in other Investment Companies    No stated policy.    The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.
Short Sales    The Fund will seek Board approval prior to utilizing short sales as an active part of investment strategy.    The Fund may not sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

   

Investment Strategy Risk – Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. There is no assurance that the Buying Fund will achieve its investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Market Risk – Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Growth Securities Risk – Because growth securities typically trade at a higher multiple of earnings than other types of securities, the market values of growth securities may be more sensitive to changes in current or expected earnings than the market values of other types of securities. In addition, growth securities, at times, may not perform as well as value securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-63-


Table of Contents

 

   

Foreign Securities Risk – Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Derivatives Risk – Derivatives are financial contracts whose values are, for example, based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or bond), assets (such as a commodity like gold or a foreign currency), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Derivatives involve special risks and may result in losses or may limit the Buying Fund’s potential gain from favorable market movements. Derivative strategies often involve leverage, which may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing the Buying Fund to lose more money than it would have lost had it invested in the underlying security. The values of derivatives may move in unexpected ways, especially in unusual market conditions, and may result in increased volatility, among other consequences. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount of taxes payable by shareholders. Other risks arise from the Buying Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell derivative positions. A liquid secondary market may not always exist for the Buying Fund’s derivative positions at times when the Buying Fund might wish to terminate or sell such positions. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid, and transactions in derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. The use of derivatives also involves the risks of mispricing or improper valuation and that changes in the value of the derivative may not correlate perfectly with the underlying security, asset, reference rate or index. The Buying Fund also may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to engage in derivative transactions when it is deemed favorable to do so, or at all. For more information on the risks of derivative investments and strategies, see the Merger SAI. The Selling Fund is not subject to derivatives risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in derivatives.

 

   

Currency Risk – Securities denominated in different currencies are subject to the risk that, for example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the U.S. dollar value of any securities held by the Buying Fund denominated in that currency. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Convertible Securities Risk – Convertible securities are subject to the usual risks associated with debt securities, such as interest rate risk and credit risk. Convertible securities also react to changes in the value of the common stock into which they convert, and are thus subject to market risk. Because the value of a convertible security can be influenced by both interest rates and market movements, a convertible security generally is not as sensitive to interest rates as a similar debt security, and generally will not vary in value in response to other factors to the same extent as the underlying common stock. In the event of a liquidation of the issuing company, holders of convertible securities would typically be paid before the company’s common stockholders but after holders of any senior debt obligations of the company. The Buying Fund may be forced to convert a convertible security before it otherwise would choose to do so, which may decrease the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to convertible securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in convertible securities.

 

   

Industry Sector Risk – At times, the Buying Fund may have a significant portion of its assets invested in securities of companies conducting business in the same industry or in a closely related group of industries within an economic sector. Companies in the same industry or sector may be similarly affected by economic or market events, making the Buying Fund more vulnerable to unfavorable developments in an industry or sector than funds that invest more broadly. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-64-


Table of Contents

 

   

Frequent Trading Risk – Frequent trading of investments increases the possibility that the Buying Fund will realize taxable capital gains (including short-term capital gains, which are generally taxable at higher rates than long-term capital gains for federal income tax purposes), which could reduce the Buying Fund’s after-tax return. Frequent trading can also mean higher brokerage and other transaction costs, which could reduce the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. Class I and Class R shares of the Buying Fund are new and Class R4 and Class R5 shares of the Buying Fund have not yet commenced operations; accordingly, performance information for those classes is not shown. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable CDSC for Class B and Class C shares;

 

   

no sales charge for Class I, Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares; and

 

   

except as noted for Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

 

-65-


Table of Contents

 

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-16.18%   -19.33%   -36.07%   +31.07%   +5.72%   +5.67%   +9.27%   +16.52%   -44.06%   +39.42%

2000

  2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +17.29% (quarter ended December 31, 2001) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -25.51% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares’ year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +3.69%.

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-1.44%   -18.80%   -26.88%   +22.19%   +7.29%   +5.00%   +10.12%   +15.18%   -40.63%   +33.61%

2000

  2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +15.51% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -23.67% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The returns shown for Class A shares include the returns of the Galaxy Equity Growth Fund, the predecessor to the Fund, for periods prior to November 18, 2002, the date on which Class A shares were initially offered by the Fund.

 

-66-


Table of Contents

 

The Fund’s Class A shares’ year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +4.03%.

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund):

   1 year     5 years     10 years     Class R* Since
inception (4/30/03)
    Class R5 Since
inception
(11/30/01)
 

Class A

          

Return before taxes

     +31.32     -0.24     -5.11     N/A        N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions

     +31.31     -0.24     -5.65     N/A        N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +20.36     -0.20     -4.20     N/A        N/A   

Class B

          

Return before taxes

     +33.10     -0.28     -5.29     N/A        N/A   

Class C

          

Return before taxes

     +37.10     +0.13     -5.27     N/A        N/A   

Class R*

          

Return before taxes

     +38.89     +0.66     N/A        +4.46     N/A   

Class R5

          

Return before taxes

     +40.03     +1.41     N/A        N/A        -0.56

Russell 1000 Growth Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +37.21     +1.63     -3.99     +5.26     +0.92

Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +38.50     +1.01     -4.51     +4.69     +0.44

Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Average (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +34.97     +0.91     -2.91     +4.73     +0.76

 

-67-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   

Columbia Large Cap Growth (Buying Fund):

   1 year     5 years     10 years  

Class A(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +25.93     -0.09     -2.66

Return after taxes on distributions

     +25.84     -0.42     -3.07

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +16.97     -0.08     -2.25

Class B(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +27.61     -0.01     -2.84

Class C(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +31.59     +0.34     -2.83

Russell 1000 Growth Index (reflects no deductions for fees, sales charges, expenses or taxes)

     +37.21     +1.63     -3.99

 

(1) The returns shown for Class A, Class B and Class C shares include the returns of the Galaxy Equity Growth Fund, the predecessor to the Fund, for periods prior to November 18, 2002, the date on which Class A, Class B and Class C shares were initially offered by the Fund.
.

 

-68-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 5. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

   

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

   

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights.

 

   

Are structured as series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Minnesota corporation and the Buying Fund is organized as series of a Delaware statutory trust. Please see Exhibit D to this combined proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Buying Fund and shareholders of the Selling Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital growth.

Buying Fund: Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed only with shareholder approval, while the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

Under normal market conditions, the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell Midcap Value Index at the time of purchase. Under normal market conditions, at least 80% of the Selling Fund’s net assets are invested in equity securities of companies with market capitalizations of up to $5 billion or that fall within the range of companies that comprise the Russell 2500TM Index at the time of investment. The Selling Fund may invest up to 25% of its net assets in foreign investments while the Buying Fund may only invest up to 20% of its net assets in foreign securities. The Buying Fund may invest in real estate investment trusts, while the Selling Fund does not do so as a principal investment strategy.

 

-69-


Table of Contents

 

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

(Buying Fund)

Under normal market conditions, at least 80% of the Fund’s net assets are invested in equity securities of companies with market capitalizations of up to $5 billion or that fall within the range of companies that comprise the Russell 2500TM Index at the time of investment. The market capitalization range and composition of the Russell 2500TM Index is subject to change.   Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of the companies in the Russell Midcap Value Index at the time of purchase (between $193 million and $14.7 billion as of August 31, 2010), that Columbia Management believes are undervalued and have the potential for long-term growth.
The Fund’s 80% policy may be changed by the Fund’s Board without shareholder approval upon sixty days notice.   The Fund’s 80% policy may be changed by the Fund’s Board without shareholder approval upon sixty days notice.
Up to 25% of the Fund’s net assets may be invested in foreign investments.   The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities.

The universe of stocks from which Columbia Management selects the Fund’s investments primarily will be those included in the Index. The Fund generally holds fewer stocks than the Index and may hold securities that are not in the Index.

 

The Fund’s investment strategy may involve frequent trading of portfolio securities. This may cause the Fund to incur higher transaction costs (which may adversely affect the Fund’s performance) and may increase taxable distributions for shareholders.

 
  The Fund normally invests in common stocks and also may invest in real estate investment trusts.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying value opportunities and constructing the Fund’s portfolio. Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

   

businesses that are believed to be fundamentally sound and undervalued due to investor indifference, investor misperception of company prospects, or other factors.

 

   

various measures of valuation, including price-to-cash flow, price-to-earnings, price-to-sales, and price-to-book value. Columbia Management believes that companies with lower valuations are generally more likely to provide opportunities for capital appreciation.

 

   

a company’s current operating margins relative to its historic range and future potential.

 

   

potential indicators of stock price appreciation, such as anticipated earnings growth, company restructuring, changes in management, business model changes, new product opportunities, or anticipated improvements in macroeconomic factors.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target set by Columbia Management; if Columbia Management believes that there has been deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

 

-70-


Table of Contents

 

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. A “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund
(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund)

Borrowing / Issuing Senior Securities   

The Fund will not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

 

The Fund will not borrow money, except for temporary purposes (not for leveraging or investment) in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings) immediately after the borrowings.

  

The Fund may not issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

 

The Fund may not borrow money except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

Commodities    The Fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from buying or selling options, futures contracts and foreign currency or from entering into forward currency contracts or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may, to the extent consistent with its investment objective, invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, and purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions, including, without limitation, forward currency contracts.
Diversification   

The Fund will not purchase more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of an issuer, except that up to 25% of the Fund’s assets may be invested without regard to this 10% limitation.

 

The Fund will not invest more than 5% of its total assets in securities of any company, government, or political subdivision thereof, except the limitation will not apply to investments in securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities, or other investment companies, and except that up to 25% of the Fund’s total assets may be invested without regard to this 5% limitation.

   The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

 

-71-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund
(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund)

Industry Concentration    The Fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the SEC, this means that up to 25% of the Fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.   

The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the

 

U.S. government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

Lending    The Fund will not lend securities or participate in an interfund lending program if the total of all such loans would exceed 33 1/3% of the Fund’s total assets except this fundamental investment policy shall not prohibit the Fund from purchasing money market securities, loans, loan participation or other debt securities, or from entering into repurchase agreements.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.
Real Estate    The Fund will not buy or sell real estate, unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from investing in securities or other instruments backed by real estate or securities of companies engaged in the real estate business or real estate investment trusts. For purposes of this policy, real estate includes real estate limited partnerships.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate and may purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate.
Underwriting    The Fund will not act as an underwriter (sell securities for others). However, under the securities laws, the Fund may be deemed to be an underwriter when it purchases securities directly from the issuer and later resells them.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might technically be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with its investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered management investment companies;

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

 

-72-


Table of Contents

 

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund
(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

(Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    No more than 15% of the Fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.

Investments in

other Investment

Companies

   No stated policy.    The Funds may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.
Short Sales    No stated policy.    The Fund may not sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

 

Investment Strategy Risk – Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. There is no assurance that the Buying Fund will achieve its investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Market Risk – Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-73-


Table of Contents

 

 

Value Securities Risk – Value securities are securities of companies that may have experienced, for example, adverse business, industry or other developments or may be subject to special risks that have caused the securities to be out of favor and, in turn, potentially undervalued. The market value of a portfolio security may not meet Columbia Management’s future value assessment of that security, or may decline. There is also a risk that it may take longer than expected for the value of these investments to rise to the believed value. In addition, value securities, at times, may not perform as well as growth securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is not subject to value securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in value securities.

 

 

Smaller Company Securities Risk – Securities of small- or mid-capitalization companies (“smaller companies”) can, in certain circumstances, have a higher potential for gains than securities of large-capitalization companies but may also have more risk. For example, smaller companies may be more vulnerable to market downturns and adverse business or economic events than larger, more established companies because they may have more limited financial resources and business operations. These companies are also more likely than larger companies to have more limited product lines and operating histories and to depend on smaller management teams. Their securities may trade less frequently and in smaller volumes and may be less liquid and fluctuate more sharply in value than securities of larger companies. In addition, some smaller companies may not be widely followed by the investment community, which can lower the demand for their stocks. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Foreign Securities Risk – Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Real Estate Investment Trusts Risk – Real estate investment trusts (“REITs”) are entities that either own properties or make construction or mortgage loans, and also may include operating or finance companies. The value of REIT shares is affected by, among other factors, changes in the value of the underlying properties owned by the REIT and/or by changes in the prospect for earnings and/or cash flow growth of the REIT itself. In addition, certain of the risks associated with general real estate ownership apply to the Buying Fund’s REIT investments, including risks related to general and local economic conditions, possible lack of availability of financing and changes in interest rates. The Selling Fund is not subject to REITs risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in REITs.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

 

-74-


Table of Contents

 

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. Class I and Class W shares of the Buying Fund are new and Class R4 shares of the Buying Fund have not yet commenced operations; accordingly, performance information for those classes is not shown. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable CDSC for Class B and Class C shares; and

 

   

except as noted for Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-10.20%   -35.78%   +26.49%
2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +18.82% (quarter ended September 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -23.52% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

The sales charge applicable to Class A shares of the Fund is not reflected in the bar chart; if reflected, returns would be lower than those shown. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares’ year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +7.80%.

 

-75-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-13.24%

  +36.53%   +20.64%   +15.02%   +16.74%   +7.38%   -41.78%   +32.25%

2002

  2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +20.74% (quarter ended September 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -27.98% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

The sales charge applicable to Class A shares of the Fund is not reflected in the bar chart; if reflected, returns would be lower than those shown. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares’ year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +7.44%.

The inception date of the Fund’s Class A shares is November 20, 2001.

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   
     1 year     Class A, B, C, I &
R4 Since
Inception
(5/18/06)
    Class W Since Inception
(12/1/06) (1)
 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund):

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +19.22     -8.67     N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions

     +19.12     -8.74     N/A   

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +12.49     -7.26     N/A   

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +20.40     -8.67     N/A   

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +24.58     -7.88     N/A   

Class I

      

Return before taxes

     +26.98     -6.80     N/A   

Class R4

      

Return before taxes

     +26.72     -6.91     N/A   

Class W

      

Return before taxes

     +26.49     N/A        -9.33

 

-76-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   
     1 year     Class A, B, C, I &
R4 Since
Inception
(5/18/06)
    Class W Since Inception
(12/1/06) (1)
 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund):

      

Russell 2500 Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +34.39     -1.53     -4.49

Lipper Mid-Cap Core Funds Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +39.34     -0.27     -2.81

 

(1) Past performance for Class W for the period prior to the beginning of operations for that class may be calculated based on the performance of Class A. The blended class performance will be adjusted to reflect differences in sales charges, but not differences in annual Fund operating expenses (for example, 12b-1 fees). The use of blended performance generally results in a presentation of higher performance for classes with higher operating expenses than those of the class with which they are blended, and a presentation of lower performance for classes with lower operating expenses than those of the class with which they are blended.

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)   
     1 year     5 years     Since  Inception(1)  

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund):

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +24.72     +0.91     +5.84

Return after taxes on distributions

     +24.56     -0.23     +4.82

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +16.22     +0.63     +4.88

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +26.16     +1.04     +5.81

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +30.17     +1.34     +5.82

Russell Midcap Value Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +34.21     +1.98     +7.36

 

(1) The inception date of the Fund’s Class A , B and C shares is November 20, 2001.

 

-77-


Table of Contents

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ABOUT EACH REORGANIZATION

Terms of the Reorganizations

The Board of each Fund has approved the Agreement. While shareholders are encouraged to review the Agreement, which has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this combined proxy statement/prospectus is a part, the following is a summary of certain terms of the Agreement:

 

 

Each Reorganization is expected to occur before the end of the second quarter of 2011, pending shareholder approval, receipt of any necessary regulatory approvals and satisfaction of any other conditions to closing. However, following such approvals, each Reorganization may happen at any time agreed to by the applicable Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund.

 

 

Each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund and, in exchange, the corresponding Buying Fund will assume all the Selling Fund’s liabilities and will issue Reorganization Shares to the Selling Fund. The value of each Selling Fund’s assets, as well as the number of Reorganization Shares to be issued to the Selling Fund, will be determined in accordance with the Agreement. The Reorganization Shares will have an aggregate net asset value on the business day immediately preceding the closing of the Reorganization equal to the value of the assets received from the Selling Fund, less the liabilities assumed by the corresponding Buying Fund in the transaction. The Reorganization Shares will immediately be distributed to Selling Fund shareholders in proportion to their holdings of shares of the Selling Fund, in liquidation of the Selling Fund. As a result, shareholders of the Selling Fund will become shareholders of the corresponding Buying Fund. No shareholders of any Selling Fund will pay any sales charge in connection with its Reorganization.

 

 

The net asset value of each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund will be computed as of the close of regular trading on the New York Stock Exchange on the business day next preceding the closing date of the applicable Reorganization.

Conditions to Closing Each Reorganization

The completion of each Reorganization is subject to certain conditions described in the Agreement, including:

 

 

The Selling Fund will have declared and paid a dividend that, together with all previous dividends, will distribute all of the Selling Fund’s net investment income and net capital gains, if any, to the shareholders of the Selling Fund for its tax year ending on or prior to the closing date of the Reorganization.

 

 

Each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund will have received any approvals, consents or exemptions from the SEC or any other regulatory body necessary to carry out the Reorganization.

 

 

A registration statement on Form N-14 relating to the Reorganization will have been filed with the SEC and become effective.

 

 

The shareholders of the Selling Fund will have approved the Agreement by the requisite vote.

 

 

The Selling Fund will have received an opinion of tax counsel to the effect that, as described in more detail in the section entitled “Tax Status of the Reorganizations,” the shareholders of the Selling Fund will not recognize gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the exchange of their Selling Fund shares for the Reorganization Shares of the corresponding Buying Fund in connection with the Reorganization.

 

 

Solely with respect to the Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, shareholders of Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund will have approved the proposed investment management services agreement approved by its Board in September 2010.

Termination of the Agreement

The Agreement and the transactions contemplated by it may be terminated and abandoned with respect to any Reorganization by resolution of the Board of any applicable Fund at any time prior to the closing date thereof. In the event of a termination, Columbia Management will bear all costs associated with the Reorganization.

 

-78-


Table of Contents

 

Tax Status of the Reorganizations

Each Reorganization is intended to qualify for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a tax-free reorganization under section 368(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). As a condition to the closing of each Reorganization, each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund will receive an opinion from Ropes & Gray LLP to the effect that, as further described below, on the basis of existing provisions of the Code, U.S. Treasury regulations issued thereunder, current administrative rules, pronouncements and court decisions, for U.S. federal income tax purposes:

 

 

The Reorganization will constitute a “reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(a)(1) of the Code, and the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund will each be “a party to a reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(b) of the Code.

 

 

Under Sections 361 and 357 of the Code, no gain or loss will be recognized by the Selling Fund upon the transfer of all of its assets to the Buying Fund in exchange for Reorganization Shares and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund, or upon the distribution of the Reorganization Shares by the Selling Fund to its shareholders in liquidation.

 

 

Under Section 354 of the Code, no gain or loss will be recognized by the shareholders of the Selling Fund upon the exchange of their Selling Fund shares for Reorganization Shares of the Buying Fund.

 

 

Under Section 358 of the Code, the aggregate tax basis of Reorganization Shares that a Selling Fund shareholder receives in the Reorganization will be the same as the aggregate tax basis of the Selling Fund shares exchanged therefor.

 

 

Under Section 1223(1) of the Code, a Selling Fund shareholder’s holding period for the Reorganization Shares received in the Reorganization will be determined by including the shareholder’s holding period for the Selling Fund shares exchanged therefor, provided the shareholder held such Selling Fund shares as capital assets.

 

 

Under Section 1032 of the Code, no gain or loss will be recognized by the Buying Fund upon the receipt of assets of the Selling Fund in exchange for Reorganization Shares and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund.

 

 

Under Section 362(b) of the Code, the Buying Fund’s tax basis in the assets of the Selling Fund transferred to the Buying Fund in the Reorganization will be the same as the Selling Fund’s tax basis in such assets immediately prior to the Reorganization.

 

 

Under Section 1223(2) of the Code, the Buying Fund’s holding periods in the assets received from the Selling Fund in the Reorganization will include the Selling Fund’s holding periods in such assets.

 

 

The Buying Fund will succeed to and take into account the items of the Selling Fund described in Section 381(c) of the Code, subject to the conditions and limitations specified in Sections 381, 382, 383 and 384 of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

Ropes & Gray LLP will express no view with respect to the effect of a Reorganization on any transferred asset as to which any unrealized gain or loss is required to be recognized under U.S. federal income tax principles (i) at the end of a taxable year or upon the termination thereof, or (ii) upon the transfer of such asset regardless of whether such a transfer would otherwise be a non-taxable transaction.

Each opinion will be based on certain factual certifications made by the officers of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund and will also be based on customary assumptions. Each opinion will note and distinguish certain published precedent. It is possible that the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) or a court could disagree with Ropes & Gray LLP’s opinion, which therefore cannot be free from doubt.

Opinions of counsel are not binding upon the IRS or the courts. If a Reorganization were consummated but did not qualify as a tax-free reorganization under the Code, a shareholder of the Selling Fund would recognize a taxable gain or loss equal to the difference between his or her tax basis in his or her Selling Fund shares and the fair market value of the Reorganization Shares of the Buying Fund he or she received. Shareholders of a Selling Fund should consult their tax advisors regarding the effect, if any, of the Reorganization in light of their individual circumstances.

Portfolio manager substitutions in connection with the closing of the acquisition by Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management, of the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC and certain of its affiliated companies from Bank of America, N.A. (the “Transaction”), and independent of the Reorganizations, have occurred and have resulted in turnover of a portion, including a substantial portion, of the portfolio assets of certain Funds. An additional portion, including a substantial portion, of the portfolio assets of each Buying or Selling Fund may also be sold at any time before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. The actual tax effect of such sales depends on the difference between the price at which such portfolio assets are sold and the tax basis in such assets of the Fund making the sale. Any capital gains recognized in

 

-79-


Table of Contents

these sales on a net basis, after reduction by any available capital losses, will be distributed to shareholders as capital gain dividends (to the extent of net realized long-term capital gains over net realized short-term capital losses) and/or ordinary dividends (to the extent of net realized short-term capital gains over net realized long-term capital losses) during or with respect to the year of sale, and such distributions will be taxable to shareholders. Each Reorganization will end the tax year of the applicable Selling Fund, and will therefore accelerate any distributions to shareholders from the Selling Fund for its short tax year ending on the date of the Reorganization. Those tax year-end distributions will be taxable and will include any undistributed capital gains resulting from portfolio turnover prior to the Reorganization.

More generally, prior to the closing of each Reorganization, the Selling Fund will, and the Buying Fund may, declare a distribution to shareholders, which, together with all previous distributions, will have the effect of distributing to shareholders all of its investment company taxable income (computed without regard to the deduction for dividends paid), net tax-exempt income, if any, and net realized capital gains, if any, through the closing of the Reorganization, including any undistributed income or gains from prior years. These distributions will be taxable to shareholders, and such distributions by a Selling Fund will include any distributable, but undistributed, capital gains resulting from portfolio turnover prior to the Reorganization. If a shareholder holds shares of either Fund in a non-taxable account, distributions with respect to those shares will not be taxable to the shareholder if the amount distributed remains in the nontaxable account.

A Fund’s ability to carry forward capital losses and to use them to offset future gains may be limited as a result of the Reorganization. First, a Fund’s “pre-acquisition losses” (including capital loss carryforwards, net current-year capital losses, and unrealized losses that exceed certain thresholds) may become unavailable to offset gains of the combined Fund to the extent such pre-acquisition losses exceed an annual limitation amount. Second, one Fund’s pre-acquisition losses cannot be used to offset gains in another Fund that are “built in” (unrealized) at the time of the Reorganization and that exceed certain thresholds (“non-de minimis built-in gains”) for five tax years. Third, a Selling Fund’s loss carryforwards, as limited under the previous two rules, are permitted to offset only that portion of the gains of the Buying Fund for the taxable year of the Reorganization that is equal to the portion of the Buying Fund’s taxable year that follows the date of the Reorganization (prorated according to number of days). Therefore, in certain circumstances, shareholders of a Fund may pay taxes sooner, or pay more taxes, than they would have had the Reorganization not occurred.

In addition, the combined Fund will have tax attributes that reflect a blending of the tax attributes of each Fund at the time of the Reorganizations (including as affected by the rules described above). Therefore, the shareholders of the Selling Fund will in each case receive a proportionate share of any “built-in” (unrealized) gains in the combined Fund’s assets, as well as any taxable income or gains realized by the Buying Fund but not distributed to its shareholders prior to the Reorganization, when such income or gains are eventually distributed by the Buying Fund. As a result, shareholders of a Selling Fund may receive a greater amount of taxable distributions than they would have had the Reorganizations not occurred. In addition, any pre-acquisition losses of the Selling Fund (whether realized or unrealized) remaining after the operation of the limitation rules described above will become available to offset capital gains realized by the combined Fund after the Reorganizations and thus may reduce subsequent capital gain distributions to a broader group of shareholders than would have been the case absent such Reorganizations, such that the benefit of those losses to Selling Fund shareholders may be further reduced relative to what the benefit would have been had the Reorganizations not occurred.

The effect of the rules described above will depend on the relative sizes of, and the losses and gains (both realized and unrealized) in, each Fund at the time of the Reorganizations and thus cannot be calculated precisely prior to the Reorganizations.

The realized and unrealized gains and losses of each Fund at the time of its Reorganization will determine the extent to which the combining Funds’ respective losses, both realized and unrealized, will be available to reduce gains realized by the combined Fund following the Reorganization, and consequently the extent to which the combined Fund may be required to distribute gains to its shareholders earlier or in greater amounts than would have been the case absent the Reorganization. The following paragraphs provide a brief summary of the tax effect of each of the Reorganizations assuming all Reorganizations occurred on February 28, 2010. As noted above, the tax effect of a Reorganization depends on each Fund’s relative tax situation at the time of the Reorganization, which situation will be different than the tax situation on February 28, 2010 and cannot be calculated precisely prior to the Reorganization. Portfolio turnover in a Fund, market fluctuations or redemption activity could cause the actual tax effect of the Reorganizations to differ substantially from that described below. For purposes of the following discussion, a Fund’s “net realized losses” consist of its capital loss carryforwards plus year-to-date net realized losses or net of year-to-date net realized gains, in each case as of February 28, 2010.

 

-80-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 1. Reorganization of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund.

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 21.0% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses with an eight-year expiration period, and unrealized net gain equal to about 16.6% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 4.6% of net assets, consisting primarily of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses with an eight-year expiration period, and unrealized net gain equal to about 15.2% of net assets.

If the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, the Buying Fund would have become subject to an annual loss limitation, but given the small proportionate size of the Buying Fund’s losses the limitation would have had little practical effect, if any. Further, the proportionately larger pre-merger losses of the Selling Fund would not have been subject to limitation and would have been fully available to offset post-merger gains of the combined Fund, thereby potentially resulting in a net tax benefit to Buying Fund shareholders. Selling Fund shareholders would have experienced a corresponding potential tax cost due to spreading Selling Fund’s proportionately larger losses across the wider shareholder base of the combined Fund. Further, the Reorganization would have permitted the Buying Fund to spread its proportionately larger unrealized net gain, if and when realized following the Reorganization, across the larger combined Fund, thereby spreading the tax cost of such gain over a larger group, resulting in a further potential tax benefit to Buying Fund shareholders, and a further potential tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders.

Proposal 2. Reorganization of Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund.

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 75.4% of net assets, consisting primarily of carryforward losses with seven- and eight-year expiration periods, and unrealized net gain equal to about 11.8% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 19.3% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses with an eight-year expiration period, and unrealized net gain equal to about 18.3% of net assets.

If the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund would have become subject to an annual loss limitation that would have limited the combined Fund’s ability to use the net realized losses of the Selling Fund to offset gains recognized by the combined Fund. The loss limitation potentially could have resulted in a greater tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders than if the Reorganization had not occurred. Further, as of that date, the Reorganization would have permitted the Buying Fund to spread its proportionately larger unrealized net gain, if and when realized following the Reorganization, across the larger combined Fund, thereby spreading the tax cost of such gain over a larger group, resulting in a potential tax benefit to Buying Fund shareholders, and further increasing the potential tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders.

Proposal 3. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I.

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 22.6% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses with seven- and eight-year expiration periods, and unrealized net gain equal to about 13.0% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 5.5% of net assets, consisting primarily of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses with an eight-year expiration period, and unrealized net gain equal to about 10.5% of net assets.

If the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund would have become subject to an annual loss limitation that would have limited the combined Fund’s ability to use the net realized losses of the Selling Fund to offset gains recognized by the combined Fund. The loss limitation potentially could have resulted in a greater tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders than if the Reorganization had not occurred. Further, while the Selling Fund had sufficient pre-merger losses to offset its net unrealized gains, Buying Fund did not. As a result, the Reorganization would have permitted the Buying Fund to spread its proportionately larger (after offset in each case by the Fund’s pre-merger losses) unrealized net gain across the larger combined Fund, thereby spreading the tax cost of such gain, if and when realized, over a larger group, resulting in a potential tax benefit to Buying Fund shareholders, and further increasing the potential tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders.

Proposal 4. Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund.

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 82.9% of net assets, consisting of carryforward losses with six-, seven- and eight-year expiration periods, and unrealized net gain equal to about 12.7% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 50.1% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses, about half of which were due to expire at the end of the then-current year and the balance in eight and nine years, and unrealized net gain equal to about 16.9% of net assets.

 

-81-


Table of Contents

 

If the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, both Funds would have become subject to annual loss limitations because the larger Selling Fund had engaged in reorganization within the preceding three years. The loss limitation rules would have limited the net realized losses of both Funds that could offset gains recognized by the combined Fund. The limitations potentially could have resulted in earlier and larger taxable distributions, and therefore a greater tax cost to shareholders, than if the Reorganization had not occurred.

Proposal 5. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund.

With respect to Proposal 5, if the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, the potential tax costs to the shareholders of both Funds due to the loss limitation rules and the blending of tax attributes would have been de minimis.

 

 

The tax principles described above will apply in each case and are not expected to change prior to the Reorganizations. However, the results of their application and, at a minimum, the specific percentages noted above will change prior to each Reorganization because of market developments and volatility in the marketplace, any pre-Reorganization realignments or other sales of portfolio securities that already have occurred or that might occur and shareholder activity in the Funds, among other changes.

This description of the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganizations is made without regard to the particular facts and circumstances of any shareholder. Shareholders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the effect, if any, of the Reorganizations in light of their individual circumstances. Because the foregoing discussion relates only to the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganizations, shareholders of a Selling Fund should also consult their tax advisors as to the state, local and foreign tax consequences, if any, of the Reorganizations.

Reasons for the Proposed Reorganizations and Board Deliberations

[[Each Reorganization was reviewed by the Board of the Selling Fund involved therein, with the advice and assistance of Fund counsel and independent legal counsel to such Board. Each Selling Fund is overseen by one Board (the “RiverSource Board”). At regular and special meetings of the RiverSource Board in May, June and August 2010, the RiverSource Board considered the Reorganization of each Selling Fund overseen by it, as proposed by Columbia Management. In connection with those Board meetings, Columbia Management and its affiliates provided background materials, analyses and other information to the RiverSource Board regarding, among other things, the topics discussed below, including responses to specific requests by the RiverSource Board, and responded to questions raised by the RiverSource Board at those meetings. The Board also considered information provided in connection with various other proposals by Columbia Management to integrate the funds advised by Columbia Management into a single fund family with greater uniformity, including proposals to standardize fees charged by Columbia Management and its affiliates, as well as other service providers, for services provided to similar funds.

After the RiverSource Board reviewed, evaluated and discussed the materials, analyses and information provided to it at its meetings that the Board considered relevant to its deliberations, the RiverSource Board, including the independent Board members thereof (the “Independent Directors”), unanimously approved the Reorganization of each Selling Fund. The RiverSource Board, including the Independent Directors, also unanimously determined that participation by each Selling Fund in its Reorganization was in the best interests of each Selling Fund and that the interests of existing shareholders of each Selling Fund would not be diluted as a result of the Reorganization.

The general factors considered by the RiverSource Board in assessing and approving each applicable Reorganization included, among others, in no order of priority:

 

  1. various potential benefits of the Reorganization to the shareholders of the Selling Funds;

 

  2. the Reorganization as part of Columbia Management’s overall commitment to streamline and to improve its fund offerings for the benefit of Fund shareholders;

 

  3. the relative similarity of investment objectives, principal investment strategies and policies of each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund and, in that connection, the anticipated continuity of investment for shareholders of each Selling Fund as it merges into its corresponding Buying Fund;

 

  4.

the estimated net operating expenses that shareholders of each class of shares of each Selling Fund are expected to experience as shareholders of the corresponding Buying Fund after the Reorganization relative to the operating expenses currently borne by such shareholders, including that, on a net basis, such expenses generally are expected

 

-82-


Table of Contents
 

to decline as a result of the Reorganization (except for Class I and R4 shareholders of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, for which such expenses are expected to increase) as a result of the Reorganization (including Columbia Management’s contractual agreement to limit the total operating expenses of the Buying Fund) (see “Fees and Expenses”);

 

  5. the current assets of each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund, and the anticipated combined pro forma assets of the Buying Fund after the Reorganization;

 

  6. the portfolio management team expected to be responsible for the management of the combined Fund and the historical performance of each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund, recognizing that no assurances can be given that the Buying Fund will achieve any particular level of performance after the Reorganization;

 

  7. the likelihood that each Selling Fund would achieve and/or maintain sufficient size to ensure its continued economic viability absent the Reorganization, the corresponding Buying Fund’s relative prospects for attracting additional assets after the Reorganization and potential economies of scale;

 

  8. the anticipated tax-free nature of the exchange of shares in the Reorganization, and other expected U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganization, including potential limitations on the Buying Fund’s use of the Funds’ pre-merger realized losses for U.S. federal income tax purposes after the Reorganization and the potential diminution of the Buying Fund’s ability to use those losses to offset future gains (see “Tax Status of the Reorganizations”);

 

  9. the potential benefits of the Reorganization to Columbia Management and its affiliates;

 

  10. that shareholders of the Selling Funds will experience no material change in shareholder services as a result of the Reorganization;

 

  11. any brokerage costs resulting from the Reorganization (e.g., each Selling Fund’s turnover associated with and resulting from the sale of any securities the corresponding Buying Fund cannot, or does not wish to acquire); and

 

  12. that the direct costs associated with the Reorganization will be borne by the Selling Funds only to the extent that Columbia Management anticipates a reduction in expenses to shareholders of the Selling Funds in the first year following the Reorganization.

In their deliberations, the RiverSource Board did not identify any single factor that was paramount or controlling and individual Board members may have attributed different weights to various factors. The RiverSource Board also evaluated the information available to it on a Selling Fund-by-Selling Fund basis, and made determinations separately in respect of each Selling Fund. Certain of the factors considered by the RiverSource Board are discussed in more detail below.

STREAMLINED PRODUCT LINE. The RiverSource Board considered that the Reorganizations are intended, among other things, to streamline Columbia Management’s product offerings by reducing the number of funds in the Combined Fund Complex. Reducing the number of funds in the complex is intended to enhance the funds’ prospects for attracting additional assets by better differentiating the funds for potential shareholders (which should lead to a more concentrated selling effort).

TAX CONSEQUENCES. The RiverSource Board examined the relative tax situations of each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund and the resulting tax impact of each proposed Reorganization to each Selling Fund’s shareholders. In that connection, as noted, the RiverSource Board considered the anticipated tax-free nature of the exchange of shares in the Reorganization, and other expected U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganization. In particular, the RiverSource Board reviewed a detailed analysis of the potential limitations on the use of each of the Seligman Capital Fund’s and the Seligman Growth Fund’s pre-merger realized losses by its corresponding Buying Fund for U.S. federal income tax purposes after the Reorganization and the potential diminution of the corresponding Buying Fund’s ability to use those losses to offset future gains. The Board also took into account information from management showing that the corresponding Buying Funds should realize, over the course of time, economic benefits from the Reorganization that should exceed the potential tax cost to those particular Selling Fund shareholders (see “Tax Status of the Reorganizations”).

 

-83-


Table of Contents

 

CONTINUITY OF INVESTMENT. Each Board took into account the fact that each applicable Selling Fund and its corresponding Buying Fund have similar investment objectives and principal investment strategies. Specifically, the RiverSource Board noted the following with respect to each Reorganization:

Proposal 1

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

The RiverSource Board noted that the Selling Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital growth while the Buying Fund seeks total return, consisting of long-term capital appreciation and current income. The RiverSource Board also noted the commonality in the Funds’ investment strategy in that both Funds normally invest primarily in large cap companies, though the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in companies with market capitalizations of over $2 billion, and the Selling Fund primarily invests in companies with market capitalizations in excess of $5 billion. The RiverSource Board also took into account that the Selling Fund may invest in foreign securities to a slightly greater extent than may the Buying Fund. The RiverSource Board further considered that, unlike the Buying Fund, the Selling Fund is subadvised by Davis Selected Advisers, L.P.

Proposal 2

Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

The RiverSource Board noted that both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund seek to provide shareholders with capital appreciation. The RiverSource Board observed the commonality in the Funds’ investment strategy in that both Funds are mid-cap equity funds. The Board did take into account that although the Selling Fund normally invests in the common stock of medium-sized U.S. companies with market capitalizations at the time of purchase of between $1 billion and $15 billion, the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell MidCap Index (currently $25 million to $15.8 billion) at the time of purchase. Nevertheless, it was observed that both Funds are currently managed in a similar manner and share a common portfolio management team.

Proposal 3

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

The RiverSource Board noted that both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund seek long-term capital appreciation. The RiverSource Board also noted the commonality in the Funds’ investment strategy in that both Funds normally invest at least 80% of their net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations within the range of companies in the Russell 2000 Value Index at the time of purchase.

Proposal 4

Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

The RiverSource Board noted that both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund seek long-term capital appreciation. The RiverSource Board also noted the commonality in the Funds’ investment strategy in that both Funds’ normally invest in securities of large capitalization companies. The RiverSource Board did take into account that the Selling Fund invests primarily in the common stock of large U.S. companies, selected for their growth prospects, and may also invest in small and mid-sized companies, while the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of large capitalization companies, primarily common stocks and securities that can be converted into common stocks. Nevertheless, it was observed that both Funds are currently managed in a similar manner and share a common portfolio management team.

Proposal 5

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

The RiverSource Board noted that both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund seek long-term capital appreciation. In considering the commonality in the Funds’ investment strategy, the RiverSource Board did take into account that the Selling Fund typically invests at least 80% of it’s net assets in equity securities of companies with market capitalizations of up to $5 billion or that fall within the range

 

-84-


Table of Contents

of companies that comprise the Russell 2500 Index at the time of investment, while the Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of the companies in the Russell Midcap Value Index (between $14.0 million and $14.7 billion as of August 31, 2010) at the time of purchase.

INVESTMENT PERFORMANCE. The RiverSource Board considered the relative performance record of each Selling Fund and of each corresponding Buying Fund, noting, however, that past performance is no guarantee of future results. Specifically, the RiverSource Board noted the following with respect to each Reorganization:

Proposal 1

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

The RiverSource Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which the Selling Fund’s performance was better for the one-year period, but the Buying Fund’s performance was significantly better for the three- and five-year periods.

Proposal 2

Seligman Capital Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

The RiverSource Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which the Selling Fund’s performance was better for the one- and ten-year periods, but the Buying Fund’s performance was better for the three- and five-year periods, and that the Buying Fund received better ratings for the all applicable periods from an independent information provider. The RiverSource Board also observed that both Funds are currently managed in a similar manner and share a common portfolio management team.

Proposal 3.

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

The RiverSource Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which the Buying Fund’s performance was better for all applicable periods.

Proposal 4

Seligman Growth Fund into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

The RiverSource Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which Seligman Growth Fund’s performance was better for the one-, three- and five-year periods, but the Buying Fund’s performance was better for the ten-year period. Nevertheless, the RiverSource Board observed that the Buying Fund received better ratings for the three- and ten-year periods and the Funds received identical ratings for the five-year period from an independent information provider. The RiverSource Board also observed that both Funds are currently managed in a similar manner and share a common portfolio management team.

Proposal 5

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

The RiverSource Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which [the Selling Fund’s performance was better for the [] period, but the Buying Fund’s performance was better for the [] periods. The Board also noted the information from management indicating that RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund has failed to attract a material amount of assets outside of funds-of-funds and [Active Portfolios] since its launch in May 2006 and that the Fund’s prospects for growth are limited. In this regard, the Board noted that the Buying Fund has long-tenured management and a relatively good performance record which should present combined Fund shareholders with an opportunity for future asset growth.

ECONOMIES OF SCALE. The RiverSource Board observed that, in addition to the potential to realize immediate economies associated with consolidating a smaller Selling Fund into a larger combined Fund, such as the elimination of duplicative costs, the combined Funds may be able to take advantage of other economies of scale associated with larger funds. For example, a larger fund may benefit more quickly from pre-established “breakpoints” in investment management services fees that are triggered as the fund’s

 

-85-


Table of Contents

net asset level increases, may have an enhanced ability to effect portfolio transactions on favorable terms and may have greater investment flexibility. Furthermore, the RiverSource Board observed that the combined fixed expenses of the larger combined Fund, such as audit and accounting expenses, could be reduced as they are spread across a larger asset base. The RiverSource Board also considered the potential benefits and economies of scale to Columbia Management resulting from the Reorganizations and whether those benefits were shared with Fund shareholders. The RiverSource Board also considered Columbia Management’s belief that each Buying Fund would be better positioned to experience growth in assets from investor inflows than each Selling Fund.

Board Recommendation and Required Vote

The RiverSource Board unanimously recommends that shareholders of each Selling Fund approve the proposed Agreement. For each Selling Fund, the Agreement must be approved by the affirmative vote of a majority of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote. A vote to approve the proposed Agreement also will constitute a vote to dissolve the applicable RiverSource Selling Fund and a vote to amend the articles of incorporation of the corporation of which the RiverSource Selling Fund is a series to provide that the RiverSource Selling Fund be acquired by the corresponding Buying Fund.

If the Agreement is not approved for a Selling Fund, the RiverSource Board will consider what further action should be taken with respect to the particular Selling Fund. The approval of the Reorganization of one Selling Fund is not conditioned upon the approval of the Reorganization of any other Selling Fund.

If shareholders approve the Reorganization of a Selling Fund, it is anticipated that the Reorganization would occur before the end of the second quarter of 2011.

 

-86-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION B – BOARD PROPOSALS

Proposal 6 - Election of Directors

(All Selling Funds)

On May 1, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management, the Selling Funds’ investment manager, acquired the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC and certain of its affiliated companies from Bank of America, N.A. (the “Transaction”). In connection with the Transaction, Columbia Management became the investment manager of the Columbia-branded funds (the “Columbia Fund Complex”), in addition to the funds then branded as RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds (the “RiverSource Fund Complex,” and together with the Columbia Fund Complex, the “Combined Fund Complex”).

Following the Transaction, the board of directors/trustees of the RiverSource Fund Complex (collectively, the “Columbia RiverSource Board”) and the board of trustees of the Columbia Fund Complex had ongoing discussions regarding a potential consolidated board of directors/trustees to oversee all or a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. In September 2010, these discussions culminated in an agreement between the Columbia RiverSource Board and the current Columbia Nations Board to have a consolidated board of directors/trustees for a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. Specifically, it was agreed that the RiverSource Fund Complex and the portion of the Columbia Fund Complex overseen by the Columbia Nations Board should be overseen by a consolidated board of directors/trustees. In this regard, the Columbia Nations Board and Columbia RiverSource Board each determined that the consolidation would enhance the oversight of a larger fund family and should achieve cost efficiencies for fund shareholders.

Each Selling Fund is a series of a corporation (a “Company” and collectively, the “Companies”). In order to effect the consolidation, at joint meetings held on September 20, 2010, the Board Governance Committee of the Columbia RiverSource Board recommended the nomination of the Independent Nominees (defined below) and the Interested Nominees (defined below) to the Columbia RiverSource Board. In addition, at joint meetings held on September 20, 2010, the Columbia RiverSource Board, including a majority of the directors/trustees who are not “interested persons,” as defined in the 1940 Act, of such Columbia RiverSource Board (each, an “Independent Director/Trustee” and collectively, the “Independent Directors/Trustees”), unanimously accepted and endorsed those nominations, nominated the Independent Nominees and Interested Nominees and voted to present each Nominee to shareholders for election as directors/trustees. The Columbia RiverSource Board currently has no reason to believe that any Nominee will become unavailable for election as a director/trustee, but if such unavailability should occur before the Meeting, the proxies will be voted for such other individuals as the Board Governance Committee of the Columbia RiverSource Board and the full Columbia RiverSource Board may designate.

A Nominee is deemed to be “independent” to the extent the Nominee is not an “interested person,” as that term is defined in Section 2(a)(19) of the 1940 Act, of the Companies (each, an “Independent Nominee” and collectively, the “Independent Nominees”). The Independent Nominees are: Kathleen Blatz, Edward J. Boudreau, Jr., Pamela G. Carlton, William P. Carmichael, Patricia M. Flynn, William A. Hawkins, R. Glenn Hilliard, Stephen R. Lewis, Jr., John F. Maher, John J. Nagorniak, Catherine James Paglia, Leroy C. Richie, Alison Taunton-Rigby and Minor M. Shaw.

William F. Truscott and Anthony M. Santomero (each, an “Interested Nominee” and collectively, the “Interested Nominees”) are or would be treated as “interested persons” of the Companies. The Companies currently treat William F. Truscott as an “interested person” of the Companies (an “Interested Director/Trustee”) because he currently as Chairman of the Board of Columbia Management (and was previously the President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management from 2001-2010) and as a senior executive of Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management, in which he is also a stockholder. The Companies would treat Anthony M. Santomero as an “interested person” of the Companies because he serves as a director of Citigroup, Inc. and Citigroup, N.A., which may engage from time to time in brokerage execution, principal transactions and/or lending relationships with the Funds or other funds or accounts advised/managed by Columbia Management and/or a Fund’s subadviser. However, Mr. Santomero is not a director, officer or employee of Columbia Management or any of its affiliates.

If the Nominees are elected by shareholders, at least 75% of the Columbia RiverSource Board’s directors/trustees will continue to be Independent Directors/Trustees. The Nominees would serve as directors/trustees in accordance with the organizational documents of the Companies. Each director/trustee would serve for an indefinite term. A director/trustee’s term may terminate by the election of his or her successor, by the termination or dissolution of the Company, or by his or her death, resignation, removal,

 

-87-


Table of Contents

retirement or incapacity. [[A director/trustee may no longer serve on the Columbia RiverSource Board after the first board meeting after he or she reaches the mandatory retirement age established by the Columbia RiverSource Board or after the 15th anniversary of the first Columbia Nations Board or Columbia RiverSource Board meeting he or she attended as a director/trustee.]]

Information Regarding the Independent Nominees

Background information regarding each of the Independent Nominees follows.

 

Name, Address and Age

  

Position(s)
Held or to
be Held
with the
Companies

  

Term of Office

and Length of

Time Served as a
Director/Trustee

  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  

Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(2)

  

Other

Directorships

Held by Nominee

During the Past Five

Years

Kathleen Blatz

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [56]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; Director/Trustee since 1/11/06    Chief Justice, Minnesota Supreme Court, 1998-2006; Attorney    [193]    None

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [66]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    Managing Director – E.J. Boudreau & Associates (consulting), from 2000 through current    [193]    BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds)

Pamela G. Carlton

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [55]

  

Director/

Trustee

  

Indefinite term;

Director/Trustee since 11/11/07

   President, Springboard-Partners in Cross Cultural Leadership (consulting company)    [193]    None

William P. Carmichael

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [67]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    Retired    [193]    BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds); Cobra Electronics Corporation (electronic equipment manufacturer); Simmons Company (bedding); The Finish Line (sportswear)

Patricia M. Flynn

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [59]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; Director/Trustee since 11/1/04    Trustee Professor of Economics and Management, Bentley University; former Dean, McCallum Graduate School of Business, Bentley University    [193]    None

William A. Hawkins

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [68]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    President and Chief Executive Officer – California Bank, N.A., from January 2008 through current    [193]    BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds)

 

-88-


Table of Contents

 

Name, Address and Age

  

Position(s)
Held or to
be Held
with the
Companies

  

Term of Office

and Length of Time
Served as a
Director/Trustee

  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  

Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(2)

  

Other

Directorships

Held by Nominee

During the Past Five

Years

R. Glenn Hilliard

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [67]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    Chairman and Chief Executive Officer – Hilliard Group LLC (investing and consulting), from April 2003 through current; Non-Executive Director & Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), September 2003 through current; Executive Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), August 2004 through September 2005    [193]    BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds); Conseco, Inc. (insurance)

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [71]

  

Director/

Trustee and Chairman of the Board

   Indefinite term; Chairman of the Board since 1/1/07 and Director/Trustee since 1/1/02    President Emeritus and Professor of Economics, Carleton College    [193]    Valmont Industries, Inc. (manufactures irrigation systems)

John F. Maher

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [67]

  

Director/

Trustee

  

Indefinite term;

Director/Trustee since 11/7/08

   Retired President and Chief Executive Officer and former Director, Great Western Financial Corporation (financial services), 1986-1997    [193]    None

John J. Nagorniak

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [66]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    Retired; President and Director – Foxstone Financial, Inc. (consulting), 2000 through December 2007; Director – Mellon Financial Corporation affiliates (investing), 2000 through 2007; Chairman – Franklin Portfolio Associates (investing – Mellon affiliate) 1982 through 2007    [193]    BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds); Research Foundation of CFA Institute; Director – MIT Investment Company; Trustee – MIT 401k Plan

Catherine James Paglia

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [57]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; 11/1/04    Director, Enterprise Asset Management, Inc. (private real estate and asset management company)    [193]    None

Leroy C. Richie

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [68]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; Director/Trustee since 11/7/08    Counsel, Lewis & Munday, P.C. since 2004; former Vice President and General Counsel, Automotive Legal Affairs, Chrysler Corporation (automotive)    [193]    Digital Ally, Inc. (digital imaging); Infinity, Inc. (oil and gas exploration and production); OGE Energy Corp. (energy and energy services)

Minor M. Shaw

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [63]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    President – Micco Corporation [(real estate development)] and Mickel Investment Group    [193]    Piedmont Natural Gas

 

-89-


Table of Contents

 

Name, Address and Age

  

Position(s)
Held or to
be Held
with the
Companies

  

Term of Office

and Length of Time
Served as a
Director/Trustee

  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  

Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(2)

  

Other

Directorships

Held by Nominee

During the Past Five

Years

Alison Taunton-Rigby

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [66]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; Director/Trustee since 11/13/02    Chief Executive Officer and Director, RiboNovix, Inc. since 2003 (biotechnology); former President, Aquila Biopharmaceuticals    [193]   

Idera Pharmaceuticals,

Inc. (biotechnology);

Healthways, Inc. (health management programs)

 

(1) If elected to serve on the Columbia RiverSource Board, an Independent Nominee would oversee [141] funds of the RiverSource Fund Complex. If the Independent Nominee also serves, or is elected to serve, on the Columbia Nations Board, then the Independent Nominee would oversee [52] funds of the Columbia Fund Complex, for a total of [193] funds across the Combined Fund Complex. The number of funds overseen by each Independent Nominee would be reduced substantially if those board-approved mergers are approved by shareholders of certain funds in the Combined Fund Complex.

Information Regarding the Interested Nominees

Background information regarding each of the Interested Nominees follows.

Name, Address and Age

  

Position(s)
Held or to
be Held
with the
Companies

  

Term of Office

and Length of

Time Served as a
Director/Trustee

  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  

Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(1)

  

Other Directorships

Held by Nominee

During the Past

Five Years

Anthony M. Santomero(2)

c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisors, LLC,

One Financial Center,

Boston, MA 02111

Age [64]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; None    Richard K. Mellon Professor Emeritus of Finance, The Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, from 1972 through current; Senior Advisor – McKinsey & Company (consulting), July 2006 through January 2008; President and Chief Executive Officer – Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia, July 2000 through April 2006    [193]    BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds); Renaissance Reinsurance Ltd.; Penn Mutual Life Insurance Company; Citigroup, Inc.; Citibank, N.A.

 

-90-


Table of Contents

Name, Address and Age

  

Position(s)
Held or to
be Held
with the
Companies

  

Term of Office and
Length of Time
Served as a
Director/Trustee

  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  

Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(1)

  

Other Directorships

Held by Nominee

During the Past

Five Years

William F. Truscott(3)

53600 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age [49]

  

Director/

Trustee

   Indefinite term; Director/Trustee since 11/7/01   

Chairman of the Board, Columbia

Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC) since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, 2001-April 2010); Senior Vice president, Atlantic Funds, Columbia Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President –

Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer, 2005-April 2010 and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, 2001-2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, 2008-April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006

   [193]    None

 

(1) If elected to serve on the Columbia RiverSource Board, each Interested Nominee would oversee [141] funds of the RiverSource Fund Complex. If the Interested Nominee also serves, or is elected to serve, on the Columbia Nations Board, then the Interested Nominee would oversee [52] funds of the Columbia Fund Complex, for a total of [193] funds across the Combined Fund Complex. The number of funds overseen by each Interested Nominee would be reduced substantially if certain board-approved mergers are approved by shareholders of those funds in the Combined Fund Complex.
(2) The Companies would treat Anthony M. Santomero as an “interested person” of the Companies for the reasons set forth above.
(3) William F. Truscott is an “interested person” of the Companies for the reasons set forth above.

Nominees’ Beneficial Ownership of Shares of Each Fund

Exhibit E of this combined proxy statement/prospectus provides information, as of September 30, 2010 (unless otherwise indicated), about the beneficial ownership by the Nominees of shares of each Fund.

Status of Current Directors/Trustees

Kathleen Blatz, Arne H. Carlson, Pamela G. Carlton, Patricia M. Flynn, Anne P. Jones, Jeffrey Laikind, Stephen R. Lewis, Jr., John F. Maher, Catherine James Paglia, Leroy C. Richie, Alison Taunton-Rigby and William F. Truscott currently comprise the entire Columbia RiverSource Board. Due to the mandatory retirement age described above, Ms. Jones and Messrs. Carlson and Laikind have not been re-nominated to serve as directors/trustees to the Columbia RiverSource Boards. The Columbia RiverSource Boards met on [•] occasions during the fiscal year ended [•]. Information about directors/trustees of the Columbia RiverSource Board who are also Nominees is set forth under “Information Regarding the Independent Nominees” and “Information Regarding the Interested Nominees” above.

 

-91-


Table of Contents

 

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

The Columbia RiverSource Board oversees management of the Companies and the Selling Funds. The Columbia RiverSource Board has a duty to act in the best interest of shareholders when supervising and overseeing the management and operations of the Companies. The Columbia RiverSource Board currently consist of twelve directors/trustees who have extensive and varied experience and skills. Eleven of the directors/trustees are Independent Directors/Trustees. Further information about the background and qualifications of each of the directors/trustees can be found in the sections titled “Information Regarding the Independent Nominees” and “Information Regarding the Interested Nominees” above.

The Columbia RiverSource Board has appointed Stephen R. Lewis, Jr., an Independent Director/Trustee, to serve in the role of Chairman. The Chairman actively participates in the development of the agendas for meetings of the Columbia RiverSource Board, presides at meetings of the Columbia RiverSource Board and acts as a liaison with service providers, officers, attorneys, and other directors/trustees generally between meetings. The Chairman may also perform such other functions as may be delegated by the Columbia RiverSource Board from time to time. Except for any duties specified herein or pursuant to the Companies’ governing documents, the designation of Chairman does not impose on such Independent Director/Trustee any duties, obligations or liability that are greater than the duties, obligations or liability imposed on such person as a member of the Columbia RiverSource Board generally.] [The Nominees have agreed, if all of the Nominees are elected by the shareholders of the Company of which they are a series, to appoint Stephen R. Lewis, Jr. as Chairman subsequent to the Meeting.

The Columbia RiverSource Board has several standing committees (the “Committees”) which are an integral part of the Selling Funds’ overall governance and risk management oversight structure. The standing Committees are the Board Governance Committee, the Compliance Committee, the Contracts Committee, the Distribution Committee, the Executive Committee, the Investment Review Committee and the Audit Committee. The roles of each Committee are more fully described in the section titled “Current Committees of the Columbia RiverSource Board” below.

The Selling Funds have retained Columbia Management as the Funds’ investment manager and administrator. Columbia Management provides the Selling Funds with investment advisory services, and is responsible for day-to-day management and administration of the Selling Funds and management of the risks that arise from the Selling Funds’ investments and operations. The Columbia RiverSource Board is responsible for overseeing Columbia Management and other service providers in the operation of the Companies, including with respect to risk management functions. The Selling Funds and the Companies are subject to a number of risks, including investment, compliance, operational, and valuation risks, among others. Day-to-day risk management functions are subsumed within the responsibilities of Columbia Management, the Selling Funds’ subadvisers and other service providers (depending on the nature of the risk), who carry out the Selling Funds’ investment management and business affairs. Each of Columbia Management, the Selling Funds’ subadvisers and other service providers has their own, independent interest in risk management, and their policies and methods of carrying out risk management functions will depend, in part, on their analysis of the risks, functions and business models.

Risk oversight forms part of the Columbia RiverSource Board’s general oversight of the Selling Funds and the Companies and is addressed as part of various activities of the Columbia RiverSource Board and Committees. The Columbia RiverSource Board recognizes that it is not possible to identify all of the risks that may affect the Selling Funds or to develop processes and controls to eliminate or even mitigate their occurrence or effects. As part of its regular oversight of the Companies, the Columbia RiverSource

 

-92-


Table of Contents

Board, directly and through one or more Committees, interacts with and reviews reports from, among others, Columbia Management, the Selling Funds’ subadvisers, the independent registered public accounting firm for the Selling Funds, and internal auditors for Columbia Management or its affiliates, as appropriate, regarding risks faced by the Selling Funds and relevant risk functions. The Columbia RiverSource Board and the Audit Committee of each Selling Fund also meet periodically with the Fund’s Chief Compliance Officer to receive reports regarding the compliance of the Fund and their principal service providers with the U.S. federal securities laws and their internal compliance policies and procedures. The Columbia RiverSource Board and its Audit Committee has oversight responsibilities with respect to the compliance program of the Selling Funds and certain of their service providers, and also receive periodic and annual reports from the Selling Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, as required under applicable regulations. The Columbia RiverSource Board, with the assistance of the Investment Committee, reviews investment policies and risks in connection with its review of each Selling Fund’s performance, and meets periodically with the portfolio managers of each Selling Fund to receive reports regarding the management of the Funds, including each Selling Fund’s investment risks. In addition, as part of the Columbia RiverSource Board’s periodic review of the Selling Funds’ advisory, subadvisory and other service provider agreements, such Columbia RiverSource Board may consider risk management aspects of their operations and the functions for which they are responsible.

The Independent Directors/Trustees have engaged independent legal counsel to assist them in performing their oversight responsibilities. The Columbia RiverSource Board reviews its leadership structure periodically and believes that its structure is appropriate because it allows the Board to exercise informed and independent judgment over matters under its purview, and it allocates areas of responsibility among Committees of directors/trustees and the full Columbia RiverSource Board in a manner that enhances effective oversight. In particular, the Columbia RiverSource Board believes that having an Independent Director/Trustee serve as the chair of the Columbia RiverSource Board and of each Committee promotes independence from Columbia Management in developing agendas and conducting meetings. The Columbia RiverSource Board believes that their Committee structure makes the oversight process more efficient and more effective by allowing smaller groups of directors/trustees to bring increased focus to matters within the purview of each Committee. The leadership structure of the Columbia RiverSource Board, including the manner in which it conducts its risk oversight role, may be changed, at any time and in the discretion of the Columbia RiverSource Board, including in response to changes in circumstances or the characteristics of the Companies.

Current Committees of the Columbia RiverSource Board

The Columbia RiverSource Board has organized the following standing Committees to facilitate its work: the Board Governance Committee, the Compliance Committee, the Contracts Committee, the Distribution Committee, the Executive Committee, the Investment Review Committee and the Audit Committee. These Committees are comprised solely of Independent Directors/Trustees. The duties of these Committees are described below.

Mr. Lewis, as Chair of the Columbia RiverSource Board, acts as a point of contact between the Independent Directors/Trustees and Columbia Management between Columbia RiverSource Board meetings in respect of general matters.

Board Governance Committee

[The Board Governance Committee recommends to the Columbia RiverSource Board the size, structure and composition of the Columbia RiverSource Board and its Committees, the compensation to be paid to members of the Columbia RiverSource Board and a process for evaluating the Columbia RiverSource Board’s performance. The Board Governance Committee also reviews candidates for Columbia RiverSource Board membership including candidates recommended by shareholders. The Board Governance Committee also makes recommendations to the Columbia RiverSource Board regarding responsibilities and duties of the Columbia RiverSource Board, oversees proxy voting and supports the work of the Board Chair in relation to furthering the interests of the Selling Funds and their shareholders on external matters.]

[To be considered as a candidate for director/trustee, recommendations must include a curriculum vitae and be mailed to the Chair of the Board, 901 Marquette Avenue South, Suite 2810, Minneapolis, MN 55402-3268. To be timely for consideration by the Board Governance Committee, the submission, including all required information, must be submitted in writing not less than 120 days before the date of the proxy statement for the previous year’s annual meeting of shareholders, if such a meeting is held. The Board Governance Committee will consider only one candidate submitted by such a shareholder or group for nomination for election at a meeting of shareholders. The Board Governance Committee will not consider self-nominated candidates or candidates nominated by members of a candidate’s family, including such candidate’s spouse, children, parents, uncles, aunts, grandparents, nieces and nephews.]

 

-93-


Table of Contents

 

[The Board Governance Committee will consider and evaluate candidates submitted by the nominating shareholder or group on the basis of the same criteria as those used to consider and evaluate candidates submitted from other sources. The Board Governance Committee may take into account a wide variety of factors in considering director/trustee candidates, including (but not limited to): (i) the candidate’s knowledge in matters relating to the investment company industry; (ii) any experience possessed by the candidate as a director/trustee or senior officer of other public or private companies; (iii) the candidate’s educational background; (iv) the candidate’s reputation for high ethical standards and personal and professional integrity; (v) any specific financial, technical or other expertise possessed by the candidate, and the extent to which such expertise would complement the Columbia RiverSource Board’s existing mix of skills and qualifications; (vi) the candidate’s perceived ability to contribute to the ongoing functions of the Columbia RiverSource Board, including the candidate’s ability and commitment to attend meetings regularly, work collaboratively with other members of the Columbia RiverSource Board and carry out his or her duties in the best interests of the fund; (vii) the candidate’s ability to qualify as an independent director/trustee; and (viii) such other criteria as the Board Governance Committee determines to be relevant in light of the existing composition of the Columbia RiverSource Board and any anticipated vacancies or other factors.]

[Members of the Board Governance Committee (and/or the Columbia RiverSource Board) also [generally] meet personally with each nominee to evaluate the candidate’s ability to work effectively with other members of the Columbia RiverSource Board, while also exercising independent judgment. Although the Columbia RiverSource Board does not have a formal diversity policy, the Columbia RiverSource Board endeavors to comprise itself of members with a broad mix of professional and personal backgrounds. Thus, the Board Governance Committee and the Columbia RiverSource Board accorded particular weight to the individual professional background of each Independent Director/Trustee.]

With respect to the directorship of Mr. Truscott, who is an Interested Nominee, the Board Governance Committee of each Columbia RiverSource Board, and the full Columbia RiverSource Board, have concluded that having a senior executive of the investment manager serve on the Columbia RiverSource Board can facilitate the Independent Directors’/Trustees’ increased access to information regarding Columbia Management, which is the Companies’ most significant service provider.

Compliance Committee

The Compliance Committee supports the Selling Funds’ maintenance of a strong compliance program by: providing a forum for Independent Directors/Trustees to consider compliance matters impacting the Selling Funds or their key service providers; developing and implementing, in coordination with the Selling Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer (“CCO”), a process for the review and consideration of compliance reports that are provided to the Columbia RiverSource Board; and providing a designated forum for the Selling Funds’ CCO to meet with Independent Directors/Trustees on a regular basis to discuss compliance matters.

Contracts Committee

The Contracts Committee reviews and oversees the contractual relationships with service providers. The Contracts Committee receives and analyzes reports covering the level and quality of services provided under contracts with the Selling Fund and advises the Columbia RiverSource Board regarding actions taken on these contracts during the annual review process.

Distribution Committee

The Distribution Committee reviews and supports product development, marketing, sales activity and practices related to the Selling Funds and will report to the Columbia RiverSource Board as appropriate.

Executive Committee

The Executive Committee acts for the Columbia RiverSource Board between meetings of the Columbia RiverSource Board.

Investment Review Committee

The Investment Review Committee reviews and oversees the management of each Selling Funds’ assets. The Investment Review Committee considers investment management policies and strategies, investment performance, risk management techniques, and securities trading practices and reports areas of concern to the Columbia RiverSource Board.

 

-94-


Table of Contents

 

Audit Committee

The Audit Committee oversees the accounting and financial reporting processes of the Selling Funds and internal controls over financial reporting. The Audit Committee oversees the quality and integrity of the Selling Funds’ financial statements and independent audits as well as the Funds’ compliance with legal and regulatory requirements relating to the Funds’ accounting and financial reporting, internal controls over financial reporting and independent audits. The Audit Committee also makes recommendations regarding the selection of the Selling Funds’ independent registered public accounting firm and reviews and evaluates the qualifications, independence and performance of the independent registered public accounting firm.

The Audit Committee oversees the Selling Funds’ risks by, among other things, meeting with the Funds’ internal auditors, establishing procedures for the confidential, anonymous submission by employees of concerns about accounting or audit matters, and overseeing the Funds’ Disclosure Controls and Procedures.

Committee Meetings

The following table shows the number of times the Committees met during each Selling Fund’s most recent fiscal period. The table is organized by fiscal-year end.

 

Fiscal Period

  Board
Governance
  Compliance   Contracts   Distribution   Executive   Investment
Review
  Audit

For Funds with fiscal periods ending May 31

  •    RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

  [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]

For Funds with fiscal periods ending July 31

  •    RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

  •    RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

  [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]

For Funds with fiscal periods ending December 31

  •    Seligman Capital Fund

  •    Seligman Growth Fund

  [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [    ]   [     ]

Nominee Qualifications

[The Companies’ Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws do not set forth any specific qualifications to serve as a director/trustee. The charter of the Board Governance Committee also does not set forth any specific qualifications, but does set forth certain factors that the Board Governance Committee may take into account in considering director/trustee candidates. The Board Governance Committee charter is attached as Exhibit F to this combined proxy statement/prospectus.

[The Board Governance Committee does not have a formal process for identifying and evaluating nominees, including nominees recommended by shareholders. Instead, the Board Governance Committee follows the process it deems appropriate under the circumstances. The attributes or skills the Board Governance Committee may take into account in considering director/trustee candidates include: (i) the candidate’s knowledge in matters relating to the investment company industry; (ii) any experience possessed by the candidate as a director or senior officer of other public or private companies; (iii) the candidate’s educational background; (iv) the candidate’s reputation for high ethical standards and personal and professional integrity; (v) any specific financial, technical or other expertise possessed by the candidate, and the extent to which such expertise would complement the Columbia RiverSource Board’s existing mix of skills and qualifications; (vi) the candidate’s perceived ability to contribute to the ongoing functions of the Board, including the candidate’s ability and commitment to attend meetings regularly, work collaboratively with other members of the Board and carry out his or her duties in the best interests of the fund; (vii) the candidate’s ability to qualify as an independent director/trustee; and (viii) such other criteria as the committee determines to be relevant in light of the existing composition of the Board and any anticipated vacancies or other factors. Members of the committee (and/or the Board) also meet personally with each nominee to evaluate the candidate’s ability to work effectively with other members of the Board, while also exercising independent judgment.]

The following is a summary of the particular professional and other experience of each Nominee that qualifies such Nominee to serve as a director/trustee of the Companies as of the date of this combined proxy statement/prospectus:

Kathleen Blatz. Ms. Blatz has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2006. Ms. Blatz has ten years of judicial experience and substantial other legal and government experience. Ms. Blatz served as an associate justice of the Minnesota Supreme Court from 1996 to 1998 and as Chief Justice of the court from 1998 to 2006. Ms. Blatz served in the Minnesota House of Representatives from 1979 to 1994.

 

-95-


Table of Contents

 

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Mr. Boudreau has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2005. In addition, he has over thirty years of business and consulting experience, primarily in the financial services industry, including as the chief executive of a mutual fund management company.

Pamela G. Carlton. Ms. Carlton has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2007. Ms. Carlton has significant experience in consulting and in investments, having served as a Managing Director in U.S. Equity Research at J.P. Morgan Chase.

William P. Carmichael. Mr. Carmichael has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 1999, and has served as Chairman of the Columbia Nations Board since 2003. Mr. Carmichael served in various senior financial and directorship positions with global consumer products companies. Mr. Carmichael is a certified public accountant and a licensed attorney.

Patricia M. Flynn. Ms. Flynn has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2004. Ms. Flynn currently serves as Trustee Professor of Economics and Management of Bentley University, and was the former dean of a graduate school of business.

William A. Hawkins. Mr. Hawkins has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2005. He currently serves as the President and Chief Executive Officer of California General Bank and has over thirty years of executive level experience in the banking industry. Mr. Hawkins is a certified financial planner and a chartered property and casualty underwriter, as well as holding series 7, 24 and 63 licenses from the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

R. Glenn Hilliard. Mr. Hilliard has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2005. Mr. Hilliard is currently the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of The Hilliard Group, LLC. Mr. Hilliard has over twenty years executive level experience in the insurance industry. Mr. Hilliard has served on the board of directors and as non-executive chairman of Conseco, Inc. for a number of years. Mr. Hilliard is also a licensed attorney.

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr. Mr. Lewis has been the Chairman of the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2007 and a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2002. From 1987 to 2002, Mr. Lewis served as President of Carleton College, after which he continued to serve as President Emeritus and Professor Emeritus of Economics. Mr. Lewis has more than thirty years experience in Asia and Africa, primarily advising governments on economic policy and negotiations of foreign investment and financing agreements. Mr. Lewis is also a director of Valmont Industries, Inc.

John F. Maher. Mr. Maher has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2008. Mr. Maher has extensive experience in the financial services industry, and was formerly President, Chief Executive Officer and a director of Great Western Financial Corporation.

John J. Nagorniak. Mr. Nagorniak has been a trustee of the trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2008. Mr. Nagorniak has served in executive level and director positions for over twenty-five years. He is a chartered financial analyst and is currently a trustee of the Research Foundation of the CFA Institute.

Catherine James Paglia. Ms. Paglia has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2004. Ms. Paglia has extensive experience in the asset management industry, and currently serves as a director of Enterprise Asset Management, Inc., a private real estate and asset management company.

Leroy C. Richie. Mr. Richie has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2008. Mr. Richie has over twenty years of legal experience, including, currently, as Counsel at Lewis & Munday, P.C., and formerly served as Vice President and General Counsel, Automotive Legal Affairs, of Chrysler Corporation from 1990 to 1997.

Anthony M. Santomero. Dr. Santomero has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2008. Dr. Santomero has over thirty years of experience as a professor of finance and private consultant specializing in issues including risk management, financial restructuring, credit risk evaluation and management, and regulation. He has served as consultant to financial institutions and agencies in the U.S. and various countries in the European Union and the European Community itself, as well as institutions in various countries around the world. Additionally, Dr. Santomero has served as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia.

Minor M. Shaw. Ms. Shaw has served as a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2003. Ms. Shaw is the President of certain private companies and is a member of the board of Piedmont Natural Gas and Blue Cross and Blue Shield of South Carolina. Ms. Shaw also serves as an active member on the boards of numerous educational and public service organizations.

 

-96-


Table of Contents

 

Alison Taunton-Rigby. Ms. Taunton-Rigby has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2002. Ms. Taunton-Rigby has been the Chief Executive Officer and a director of RiboNovix, Inc. since 2003. She also formerly served as the President of Aquila Biopharmaceuticals.

William F. Truscott. Mr. Truscott has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Boards since 2001. Mr. Truscott has over nine years of experience as President and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management, and currently serves as Chairman of the board of Columbia Management. Mr.  Truscott is also an executive officer of Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management.

Procedures for Communications to the Columbia RiverSource Board

Shareholders who want to communicate with the Columbia RiverSource Board or an individual director/trustee should send written communications to 901 S. Marquette Ave., Minneapolis, MN 55402, addressed to the board of directors/trustees of the Company or the individual director/trustee. The Secretary [of the Company] may determine not to forward to the Columbia RiverSource Board or individual directors/trustees any letter that does not relate to the business of a Fund.

Executive Officers of the Companies

Information about the executive officers of each Company is included in Exhibit G of this combined proxy statement/prospectus.

Remuneration for Directors/Trustees and Officers

The Independent Directors/Trustees determine the amount of compensation that they receive, including the amount paid to the Chair of the Columbia RiverSource Board. In determining compensation for the Independent Directors/Trustees, the Independent Directors/Trustees take into account a variety of factors including, among other things, their collective significant work experience (e.g., in business and finance, government or academia). The Independent Directors/Trustees also recognize that these individuals’ advice and counsel are in demand by other organizations, that these individuals may reject other opportunities because of the time demands of their duties as Independent Directors/Trustees, and that they undertake significant legal responsibilities. The Independent Directors/Trustees also consider the compensation paid to independent board members of other mutual fund complexes of comparable size. In determining the compensation paid to the Chair, the Independent Directors/Trustees take into account, among other things, the Chair’s significant additional responsibilities (e.g., setting the agenda for Columbia RiverSource Board meetings, communicating or meeting regularly with the Funds’ CCO, counsel to the Independent Directors/Trustees, and the Funds’ service providers) which result in a significantly greater time commitment required of the Columbia RiverSource Board Chair. The Chair’s compensation, therefore, has generally been set at a level between 2.5 and 3 times the level of compensation paid to other Independent Directors/Trustees.

Independent Directors/Trustees are currently paid an annual retainer of $125,000. Committee and subcommittee Chairs each receive an additional annual retainer of $5,000. In addition, Independent Directors/Trustees are paid the following fees for attending Columbia RiverSource Board and Committee meetings: $5,000 per day of in-person Columbia RiverSource Board meetings and $2,500 per day of in-person Committee or sub-committee meetings (if such meetings are not held on the same day as a Columbia RiverSource Board meeting). Independent Directors/Trustees are not paid for special meetings conducted by telephone. In 2010, the Columbia RiverSource Board’s Chair will receive total annual cash compensation of $430,000. [Persons who are employees, officers or directors of Columbia Management receive no remuneration for serving as directors of the Companies.]

The Independent Directors/Trustees may elect to defer payment of up to 100% of the compensation they receive in accordance with a Deferred Compensation Plan (the Deferred Plan). Under the Deferred Plan, a Columbia RiverSource Board Director/Trustee may elect to have his or her deferred compensation treated as if they had been invested in shares of one or more Funds in the RiverSource Fund Complex and the amount paid to the Columbia RiverSource Board member under the Deferred Plan will be determined based on the performance of such investments. Distributions may be taken in a lump sum or over a period of years. The Deferred Plan will remain unfunded for U.S. federal income tax purposes under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). It is anticipated that deferral of Columbia RiverSource Board member compensation in accordance with the Deferred Plan will have, at most, a negligible impact on fund assets and liabilities. See Exhibit H for information on the amount of compensation paid to the Directors/Trustees on a Fund-by-Fund basis and in the aggregate.

 

-97-


Table of Contents

 

Required Vote and Recommendation

Election of directors of a Company requires the affirmative vote of a plurality of the voting power of the shares of each series thereof (voting together as a single class) present and entitled to vote at the Meeting. Shareholders of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund are entitled to cumulate those votes.

For RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, this Proposal 6 is contingent on Proposal 7 to the extent that if shareholders of a Company elect all 16 Nominees but do not approve the proposed amendment to such Company’s Articles of Incorporation, then William F. Truscott, an “interested person” of the Companies as defined in section 2(a)(19) of the 1940 Act, will not continue as a director of that Company.

THE COLUMBIA RIVERSOURCE BOARD UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT YOU VOTE FOR THE ELECTION OF EACH NOMINEE.

 

-98-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 7 – Amending the Articles of Incorporation to Increase the Maximum Number of Board Members

(RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund only)

As discussed above under Proposal 6, the Columbia Nations Board and the Columbia RiverSource Board have agreed to have a consolidated board of directors/trustees for a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. In order to effect the board of directors/trustees consolidation discussed above, ][the Board Governance Committee of the Columbia RiverSource Board has recommended, and the full Columbia RiverSource Board has nominated,]] the 16 Nominees for election to the Columbia RiverSource Board, as further described in Proposal 6 (election of directors/trustees). However, the applicable Articles of Incorporation (“Charters”) of each of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund currently provide that Company of which each is a series can have no more than 15 directors. Accordingly, it is proposed that the applicable provisions of these Companies’ Charters be amended (a) to increase the maximum permissible number of directors to twenty (20) and (b) to provide that any future change in the actual number of directors within the stated range (e.g., an increase beyond 16 directors) shall require the approval of at least seventy-five percent (75%) of the directors then serving.

The relevant provisions of the Charters of each of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, and the proposed language that would be included in each Fund’s Charter, are set forth below:

 

Current Language

 

Proposed Language

The directors, of which there shall be not less than two nor more than fifteen, shall be elected at the first meeting of the shareholders for an indefinite term and thereafter at each regular meeting of shareholders, to hold office for an indefinite term until the next regular meeting of shareholders, but in any event, they shall hold office until their successors are elected and qualify. The number of directors may be increased or decreased from time to time by action of the Board of Directors.   The directors, of which there shall be not less than two nor more than twenty, shall be elected at the first meeting of the shareholders for an indefinite term and thereafter at each regular meeting of shareholders, to hold office for an indefinite term until the next regular meeting of shareholders, but in any event, they shall hold office until their successors are elected and qualify. The number of directors may be increased or decreased from time to time by action of at least seventy-five percent of the Directors.
These Articles of Incorporation, or any provision hereof, may be amended, altered, changed or repealed in the manner prescribed by the laws of the State of Minnesota.   These Articles of Incorporation, or any provision hereof, may be amended, altered, changed or repealed in the manner prescribed by the laws of the State of Minnesota, provided that Section 2 of Article IV [the provision set forth above governing changes in the number of Directors] may not be repealed, modified or changed without the approval of seventy-five percent of the Directors.

The proposed amendment to RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund Charters would also provide that any future change to such Charters’ provisions regarding the establishment of a maximum or minimum number of directors would require the approval of seventy-five percent (75%) of the directors then in office, in addition to any approval by shareholders of the Company of which RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund are series which may be required under their Charters.

Required Vote and Recommendation

The proposed amendment to RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund’s, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund’s and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund’s Charters requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting power of the shares of each series of each Company (voting together as a single class) present and entitled to vote at the Meeting.

 

-99-


Table of Contents

 

THE COLUMBIA RIVERSOURCE BOARD OF UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT SHAREHOLDERS VOTE FOR THE AMENDMENT TO ITS CHARTER.

 

-100-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION C — PROXY VOTING AND SHAREHOLDER MEETING INFORMATION

Voting. Shareholders of record of each Selling Fund on December 17, 2010 (the “Record Date”) are entitled to vote at the Meeting. With respect to each Reorganization, and, as applicable, the proposed amendments to the Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Managers Series, Inc. and RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc., shares of each of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund are entitled to one vote for each dollar of net asset value, or a proportional fractional vote for each fractional dollar, represented by those shares on the Record Date, and shares of each of Seligman Capital Fund and Seligman Growth Fund are entitled to one vote per share or a proportionate fractional vote for each fractional share. All share classes of a Selling Fund will vote together as one class on the Selling Fund’s proposed Reorganization. With respect to the election of Nominees and the amendment of the Articles of Incorporation, shareholders of each applicable Board Election Fund will vote together with shareholders of each other series of the entity of which such Fund is a series, if any, as a single class. Each shareholder of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund is entitled to a number of votes equal to the number of dollars of net asset value of shares owned multiplied by the number of Directors to be elected and may cast all of such votes for a single Director or may distribute them among the number to be voted for, or any two or more of them. For Seligman Capital Fund and Seligman Growth Fund, there is no cumulative voting in the election of directors.

Quorum and Methods of Tabulation. A quorum is required for shareholders of a Selling Fund to take action at the Meeting. For RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, ten percent (10%) of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote, present at the Meeting in person or by proxy, constitutes a quorum. For Seligman Capital Fund and Seligman Growth Fund, thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote, present at the Meeting in person or by proxy, constitutes a quorum.

All shares represented at the Meeting in person or by proxy will be counted for purposes of establishing a quorum. Broker non-votes will be counted for purposes of establishing a quorum but not toward the approval of any proposal or the election of Nominees. (Broker non-votes are shares for which the underlying owner has not voted and the broker holding the shares does not have authority to vote.) With respect to the election of Nominees, neither abstentions nor broker non-votes will have an effect on the outcome of the proposal. With respect to each Reorganization, and the proposed amendments to the Articles of Incorporation of RiverSource Managers Series, Inc. and RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc., abstentions and broker non-votes will have the effect of votes against the proposal. In certain circumstances in which a Fund has received sufficient votes to approve a Reorganization, the Fund may request that brokers and nominees, in their discretion, withhold submission of broker non-votes in order to avoid the need for solicitation of additional votes in favor of the proposal. A Fund may also request that selected brokers and nominees, in their discretion, submit broker non-votes, if doing so is necessary to obtain a quorum.

If your shares are held in an IRA account with Ameriprise Trust Company as custodian (the “IRA Custodian”), you have the right to instruct the IRA Custodian how to vote those shares. For each applicable Selling Fund, the IRA Custodian will vote any shares for which it has not received voting instructions in proportionately the same manner as other shareholders of that Selling Fund have voted.

Shareholder Proxies. If you properly authorize your proxy by internet or telephone, or by executing and returning the enclosed proxy card by mail, and your proxy is not subsequently revoked, your vote will be cast at the Meeting and at any postponement or adjournment thereof. If you give instructions, your vote will be cast in accordance with your instructions. If you return your signed proxy card without instructions, your vote will be cast in favor of the Reorganization of your Selling Fund, for each Board Election Fund, your vote will be cast FOR the election of each Nominee, and, for RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, your vote will be cast FOR the proposed amendments to your respective Fund’s Articles of Incorporation.

Proxy Statement Delivery. “Householding” is the term used to describe the practice of delivering one copy of a document to a household of shareholders instead of delivering one copy of a document to each shareholder in the household. Certain shareholders of the Selling Funds who share a common address and who have not opted out of the householding process may receive a single copy of the combined proxy statement/prospectus along with the proxy cards. If you received more than one copy of the combined proxy statement/prospectus, you may elect to household in the future if permitted by your financial intermediary. Contact the financial intermediary through which you purchased your shares to determine whether householding is an option for your account. If you received a single copy of the combined proxy statement/prospectus, you may opt out of householding in the future by contacting your financial intermediary.

 

-101-


Table of Contents

 

An additional copy of this combined proxy statement/prospectus may be obtained by writing to [] at [] or by calling the Selling Funds’ proxy solicitor, Computershare Fund Services, toll free, at (800) 708-7953.

Revoking Your Proxy. If you execute, date and submit a proxy card with respect to your Selling Fund, you may revoke your proxy prior to the meeting by providing written notice to the Funds’ proxy solicitor at Computershare Fund Services, c/o Operation Department, 280 Oser Avenue, Hauppauge, NY 11788, or change your vote by submitting a subsequently executed and dated proxy card, by authorizing your proxy by internet or telephone on a later date or by attending the Meeting and casting your vote in person. If you authorize your proxy by internet or telephone, you may change your instructions prior to the meeting by authorizing a subsequent proxy by internet or telephone or by completing, signing and returning a proxy card dated as of a date that is later than your last internet or telephone proxy authorization or by attending the Meeting and casting your vote in person. Merely attending the Meeting without voting will not revoke your prior proxy.

Simultaneous Meetings. The meeting for each Selling Fund will be held simultaneously with the meeting for each other Selling Fund, with each proposal being voted on separately by the shareholders of the relevant Selling Fund. If any shareholder objects to the holding of simultaneous meetings, the shareholder may move for an adjournment of his or her Selling Fund’s meeting to a time after the Meeting so that a meeting for that Selling Fund may be held separately. If a shareholder makes this motion, the persons named as proxies will take into consideration the reasons for the objection in deciding whether to vote in favor of the adjournment, and may vote for or against the adjournment in their discretion.

Solicitation of Proxies. The Board is asking for your vote and for you to vote as promptly as possible. The expenses of the solicitation will be allocated to each Fund subject to the limitations described in Exhibit A. Proxies will be solicited primarily through the mailing of the Prospectus/Proxy Statement and its enclosures, but proxies also may be solicited through further mailings, telephone calls, personal interviews or e-mail by officers of each Selling Fund or by employees or agents of Columbia Management and its affiliated companies. In addition, Computershare Fund Services, 280 Oser Avenue, Hauppauge, NY 1178, has been engaged to assist in the solicitation of proxies, at the estimated cost set forth below, plus expenses.

 

Fund

   Estimated Cost  

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

   $ [

Seligman Capital Fund

   $ [

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

   $ [

Seligman Growth Fund

   $ [

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

   $ [

Shareholder Proposals. The Selling Funds do not hold annual meetings of shareholders. Shareholders who wish to make a proposal not involving the nomination of a person for election as a director or trustee at a Selling Fund’s next special meeting that may be included in the Selling Fund’s proxy materials must notify the relevant Selling Fund a reasonable amount of time before the Selling Fund begins to print and mail its proxy materials. The fact that a Selling Fund receives such a shareholder proposal in a timely manner does not ensure inclusion of the proposal in the proxy materials, because there are other requirements in the proxy rules relating to such inclusion.

Dissenters’ Right of Appraisal.

Shareholders of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund may be entitled to assert appraisal rights under Sections 302A.471 and 302A.473 of the Minnesota Business Corporation Act in connection with their Selling Fund’s Reorganization and to obtain payment of the “fair value” of their Selling Fund shares, provided that they comply with the requirements of Minnesota law. A copy of the relevant provisions of the Minnesota Business Corporation Act is attached as Exhibit B hereto.

Notwithstanding Minnesota law, the SEC has taken the position that the use of state appraisal procedures by a mutual fund, such as the Selling Funds, would be a violation of Rule 22c-1, the forward-pricing rule, under the 1940 Act. This rule states that no mutual fund may redeem its shares other than at the net asset value next computed after receipt of a request for redemption. It is the SEC’s position that Rule 22c-1 supersedes appraisal provisions in state statutes.

In the interest of ensuring equal valuation for all Selling Fund shareholders, dissenters’ rights will be determined in accordance with the SEC’s interpretation. As a result, if any shareholder elects to exercise dissenters’ rights under Minnesota law, the relevant Selling

Fund intends to submit the question to a court of competent jurisdiction. In that event, a dissenting shareholder would not receive any payment until the end of the court proceeding.

 

-102-


Table of Contents

 

Other Business. The Board of each Selling Fund does not know of any matters to be presented at the Meeting other than the Reorganizations, the amendments to the Articles of Incorporation, and the election of Nominees. If other business should properly come before the Meeting, the persons named as proxies will vote thereon in their discretion.

Adjournment. If the quorum required for the Meeting has not been met for any Selling Fund, the persons named as proxies may propose adjournment of the Meeting and vote all shares that they are entitled to vote in favor of such adjournment. If the quorum required for the Meeting has been met, but sufficient votes in favor of one or more proposals are not received by the time scheduled for the Meeting, then the persons named as proxies may move for one or more adjournments of the Meeting as to one or more proposals to allow further solicitation of shareholders. The procedures for adjournment of the Meeting for each Selling Fund are as follows:

 

 

For RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, if a quorum is not present, the Meeting may be adjourned without notice other than notice at the Meeting, and may otherwise be adjourned by the affirmative vote of a majority of the shares of each series thereof (voting together as a single class) voted at the Meeting.

 

 

For Seligman Capital Fund and Seligman Growth Fund, the Meeting may be adjourned, whether or not a quorum is present, by the holders of a majority of the shares present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote. If the Meeting is adjourned, notice does not need to be given of the adjourned Meeting date, other than announcement at the Meeting. In addition, if a quorum is not present, the chairman may also adjourn the Meeting, and set a date for the adjourned Meeting not more than 120 days after the Record Date without notice other than announcement at the Meeting.

The persons named as proxies will vote in favor of adjournment with respect to a proposal those shares they are entitled to vote in favor of such proposal. They will vote against any such adjournment those shares they are required to vote against such proposal. The costs of any additional solicitation and of any adjourned Meeting will be borne in the same manner as the other expenses associated with the proposals described herein. Any proposal for which sufficient favorable votes have been received may be acted upon and considered final regardless of whether the Meeting is adjourned to permit additional solicitation with respect to any other proposal.

 

-103-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION D — CAPITALIZATION, OWNERSHIP OF FUND SHARES AND FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

This section contains the following information about the Buying Funds and the Selling Funds (all information is shown for the most recently ended fiscal year unless otherwise noted):

 

Table

  

Content

D-1

   Current and pro forma capitalization of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund

D-2

   Current and pro forma ownership of shares of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund

D-3

   Financial highlights of each Buying Fund

The Funds’ Investment Manager and Distributor. Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110 is the investment manager for each Fund. Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111 is the distributor for each Fund.

Capitalization of Selling Funds and Buying Funds

The following table shows the capitalization of each Fund as of September 30, 2010 for RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Seligman Growth Fund and Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund; as of August 31, 2010 for Seligman Capital Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small & Mid Cap Equity Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund; and as of June 30, 2010 for RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I and, with respect to the Buying Fund, on a pro forma basis, assuming the proposed Reorganization had taken place as of that date. The pro forma combined net assets are determined by adding the net assets of the Selling Funds and the net assets of the Buying Fund. The pro forma combined shares outstanding are determined by dividing the net assets of the Selling Funds by the net asset value per share of the corresponding Buying Fund and adding the actual shares outstanding of the Buying Fund.

Table D-1. Actual and Pro Forma Capitalization of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund

 

Fund

   Net assets      Net asset value
per share
     Shares
outstanding
 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund
(Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 307,276,383       $ 5         67,189,864   

Class B

   $ 35,146,263       $ 4         8,051,497   

Class C

   $ 8,172,223       $ 4         1,865,549   

Class I

   $ 180,340,440       $ 5         38,917,841   

Class R4

   $ 123,877       $ 5         26,881   

Total

   $ 531,059,186            116,051,632   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Current)
(Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 111,182,019       $ 13         8,816,877   

Class B

   $ 3,990,937       $ 12         338,703   

Class C

   $ 18,368,411       $ 12         1,557,077   

Class I

   $ 2,497       $ 13         197   

Class R

   $ 2,497       $ 13         198   

Class T

   $ 112,861,722       $ 13         9,019,636   

Class W

   $ 2,497       $ 13         198   

Class Z

   $ 344,080,992       $ 13         27,128,637   

Total

   $ 590,491,572            46,861,523   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Pro Forma
Combined)**

        

Class A

   $ 418,406,699       $ 13         33,180,635   

Class B

   $ 39,131,467       $ 12         3,321,777   

Class C

   $ 26,538,939       $ 12         2,249,527   

Class I

   $ 180,313,946       $ 13         14,209,137   

Class R2

   $ 2,497       $ 13         198   

Class R4

   $ 123,857       $ 13         9,822   

Class T

   $ 112,859,381       $ 13         9,019,636   

Class W

   $ 2,497       $ 13         198   

Class Z

   $ 344,073,857       $ 13         27,128,637   

Total

   $ 1,121,453,140            89,119,567   

 

-104-


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Net assets      Net asset value
per share
     Shares
outstanding
 

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 146,622,777       $ 19.98         7,337,030   

Class B

   $ 3,651,496       $ 16.11         226,620   

Class C

   $ 38,803,354       $ 16.16         2,401,898   

Class I

   $ 12,170,883       $ 20.93         581,385   

Class R*

   $ 10,642,835       $ 19.70         540,381   

Class R5

   $ 1,748,948       $ 20.92         83,600   

Total

   $ 213,640,293            11,170,914   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 65,123,044       $ 20.22         3,220,423   

Class B

   $ 5,581,662       $ 18.93         294,859   

Class C

   $ 9,858,493       $ 18.98         519,318   

Class R*

   $ 5,112,378       $ 19.98         255,838   

Class T

   $ 19,581,597       $ 20.21         968,882   

Class Y

   $ 1,013,072       $ 20.72         48,889   

Class Z

   $ 986,589,782       $ 20.72         47,615,723   

Total

   $ 1,092,860,028            52,923,932   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma Combined)**

        

Class A

   $ 211,647,163       $ 20.22         10,466,918   

Class B

   $ 9,230,701       $ 18.93         487,624   

Class C

   $ 48,635,737       $ 18.98         2,562,376   

Class I

   $ 12,162,694       $ 20.72         587,003   

Class R*

   $ 15,748,052       $ 19.98         788,154   

Class R5

   $ 1,747,771       $ 20.22         86,438   

Class T

   $ 19,581,597       $ 20.21         968,882   

Class Y

   $ 1,013,072       $ 20.72         48,889   

Class Z

   $ 986,589,782       $ 20.72         47,615,723   

Total

   $ 1,306,356,569            63,612,007   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 3,310,291.00       $ 7.30         453,634   

Class B

   $ 179,299.00       $ 7.17         24,998   

Class C

   $ 112,256.00       $ 7.17         15,654   

Class I

   $ 44,199,648.00       $ 7.31         6,042,689   

Class R*

   $ 3,317.00       $ 7.29         455   

Class R4

   $ 4,726.00       $ 7.29         648   

Total

   $ 47,809,537.00            6,538,078   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 593,209,149.00       $ 35.84         16,553,689   

Class B

   $ 22,775,432.00       $ 29.17         780,724   

Class C

   $ 49,887,864.00       $ 30.87         1,616,212   

Class Y

   $ 1,110,772.00       $ 37.63         29,518   

Class Z

   $ 774,590,489.00       $ 37.60         20,602,843   

Total

   $ 1,441,573,706.00            39,582,986   

 

-105-


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Net assets      Net asset value
per share
     Shares
outstanding
 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Pro Forma Combined)**

        

Class A

   $ 596,517,941.00       $ 35.84         16,646,010   

Class B

   $ 22,954,650.00       $ 29.17         786,868   

Class C

   $ 50,000,069.00       $ 30.87         1,619,847   

Class I

   $ 44,179,629.00       $ 37.60         1,174,990   

Class R

   $ 3,315.00       $ 35.84         92   

Class R4

   $ 4,724.00       $ 35.84         132   

Class Y

   $ 1,110,772.00       $ 37.63         29,518   

Class Z

   $ 774,590,489.00       $ 37.60         20,602,843   

Total

   $ 1,489,361,589.00            40,860,300   

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc. (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 1,178,940,831       $ 4         279,109,185   

Class B

   $ 68,386,621       $ 3         20,735,393   

Class C

   $ 26,226,878       $ 3         7,950,238   

Class I

   $ 245,225,117       $ 4         55,881,676   

Class R

   $ 1,728,127       $ 4         417,159   

Class R4

   $ 45,149,928       $ 4         10,311,388   

Class R5

   $ 435,936       $ 4         99,435   

Total

   $ 1,566,093,438            374,504,474   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 148,455,253       $ 21         7,193,914   

Class B

   $ 14,526,570       $ 19         765,782   

Class C

   $ 15,989,900       $ 19         842,508   

Class E

   $ 12,800,418       $ 21         621,432   

Class F

   $ 425,226       $ 19         22,427   

Class I

   $ 2,495       $ 21         118   

Class R

   $ 2,495       $ 21         121   

Class T

   $ 143,783,874       $ 20         7,016,073   

Class W

   $ 2,495       $ 21         121   

Class Y

   $ 22,272,056       $ 21         1,053,680   

Class Z

   $ 860,959,491       $ 21         40,760,043   

Total

   $ 1,219,220,273            58,276,219   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Pro Forma Combined)**

        

Class A

   $ 1,326,845,237       $ 21         64,286,452   

Class B

   $ 82,881,238       $ 19         4,369,086   

Class C

   $ 42,204,524       $ 19         2,223,679   

Class E

   $ 12,800,418       $ 21         621,432   

Class F

   $ 425,226       $ 19         22,427   

Class I

   $ 245,113,033       $ 21         11,594,751   

Class R

   $ 1,729,815       $ 21         83,809   

Class R4

   $ 45,128,832       $ 21         2,186,474   

Class R5

   $ 435,732       $ 21         21,111   

Class T

   $ 143,783,874       $ 20         7,016,073   

Class W

   $ 2,495       $ 21         121   

Class Y

   $ 22,272,056       $ 21         1,053,680   

Class Z

   $ 860,959,491       $ 21         40,760,043   

Total

   $ 2,784,581,971            134,239,138   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 8,850,337       $ 6.97         1,269,945   

Class B

   $ 543,983       $ 6.77         80,295   

Class C

   $ 186,329       $ 6.78         27,486   

Class I

   $ 25,453,843       $ 7.00         3,634,953   

Class R4

   $ 8,419       $ 6.98         1,206   

Class W

   $ 95,627,946       $ 6.94         13,775,748   

Total

   $ 130,670,857            18,789,633   

 

-106-


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Net assets      Net asset value
per share
     Shares
outstanding
 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 1,273,014,308       $ 10.79         118,021,312   

Class B

   $ 45,706,803       $ 10.52         4,344,219   

Class C

   $ 151,738,190       $ 10.56         14,368,533   

Class R

   $ 270,655,614       $ 10.78         25,114,055   

Class Y

   $ 12,282       $ 10.78         1,139   

Class Z

   $ 2,300,306,252       $ 10.80         212,976,277   

Total

   $ 4,041,433,449            374,825,535   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Pro Forma Combined)**

        

Class A

   $ 1,281,856,940       $ 10.79         118,840,833   

Class B

   $ 46,250,312       $ 10.52         4,395,883   

Class C

   $ 151,924,357       $ 10.56         14,386,162   

Class I

   $ 25,431,683       $ 10.80         2,354,785   

Class R

   $ 270,655,614       $ 10.78         25,114,055   

Class R4

   $ 8,412       $ 10.79         780   

Class W

   $ 95,544,693       $ 10.79         8,854,930   

Class Y

   $ 12,282       $ 10.78         1,139   

Class Z

   $ 2,300,306,252       $ 10.80         212,976,277   

Total

   $ 4,171,990,545            386,924,844   

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Capital Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and Seligman Growth Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
** Pro forma figures reflect the effect of estimated Reorganization costs.

Ownership of Selling Fund and Buying Fund Shares

The following table provides information on each person who may be deemed to be a “control person” (as that term is defined in the 1940 Act) of a Fund as of October 31, 2010 because it owns, directly or indirectly, of record more than 25% of the outstanding shares of the Fund, by virtue of its fiduciary roles with respect to its clients or otherwise. A control person may be able to facilitate shareholder approval of proposals it favors and to impede shareholder approval of proposals it opposes. In this regard, if a control person owns a sufficient number of a Fund’s outstanding shares, then, for certain shareholder proposals, such control person may be able to approve, or to prevent approval, of such proposals without regard to votes by other Fund shareholders.

[Table to be inserted, including parent’s name and address and state of jurisdiction of all control persons that are companies]

The following table provides information on shareholders who owned of record or, to the knowledge of the Fund, beneficially, more than 5% of any class of a Fund’s outstanding shares as of October 31, 2010. [[As of October 31, 2010, the officers and directors of each Fund, as a group, owned less than 1% of the outstanding shares of each class of such Fund.]]

 

-107-


Table of Contents

 

Table D-2. Current and Pro Forma Ownership of Fund Shares

 

Fund

  

>5% owners

        Percent of
shares held
    Percent of shares
held following
Reorganization
 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

    

Class A

   []         []%        N/A   

Class B

   []         []%        N/A   

Class C

   []         []%        N/A   

Class I

   []         []%        N/A   

Class R4

   []         []%        N/A   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund) (Current and Pro Forma)

    

Class A

   []         []%        []%   

Class B

   []         []%        []%   

Class C

   []         []%        []%   

Class I

   []         []%        []%   

Class R

   []         []%        []%   

Class R4

   []         []%        []%   

Class T

   []         []%        []%   

Class W

   []         []%        []%   

Class Z

   []         []%        []%   

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

    

Class A

   []         []%        N/A   

Class B

   []         []%        N/A   

Class C

   []         []%        N/A   

Class I

   []         []%        N/A   

Class R*

   []         []%        N/A   

Class R5

   []         []%        N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund) (Current and Pro Forma)

    

Class A

   []         []%        []%   

Class B

   []         []%        []%   

Class C

   []         []%        []%   

Class I

   []         []%        []%   

Class R

   []         []%        []%   

Class R5

   []         []%        []%   

Class T

   []         []%        []%   

Class W

   []         []%        []%   

Class Y

   []         []%        []%   

Class Z

   []         []%        []%   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Selling Fund)

    

Class A

   []         []%        N/A   

Class B

   []         []%        N/A   

Class C

   []         []%        N/A   

Class I

   []         []%        N/A   

Class R*

   []         []%        N/A   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Buying Fund) (Current and Pro Forma)

    

Class A

   []         []%        []%   

Class B

   []         []%        []%   

 

-108-


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

>5% owners

        Percent of
shares held
  Percent of shares
held following
Reorganization

Class C

   []       []%   []%

Class I

   []       []%   []%

Class R

   []       []%   []%

Class Y

   []       []%   []%

Class Z

   []       []%   []%

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

    

Class A

   []       []%   N/A

Class B

   []       []%   N/A

Class C

   []       []%   N/A

Class I

   []       []%   N/A

Class R*

   []       []%   N/A

Class R4

   []       []%   N/A

Class R5

   []       []%   N/A

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund) (Current and Pro Forma)

    

Class A

   []       []%   []%

Class B

   []       []%   []%

Class C

   []       []%   []%

Class E

   []       []%   []%

Class F

   []       []%   []%

Class I

   []       []%   []%

Class R

   []       []%   []%

Class R4

   []       []%   []%

Class R5

   []       []%   []%

Class T

   []       []%   []%

Class W

   []       []%   []%

Class Y

   []       []%   []%

Class Z

   []       []%   []%

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

    

Class A

   []       []%   N/A

Class B

   []       []%   N/A

Class C

   []       []%   N/A

Class I

   []       []%   N/A

Class R4

   []       []%   N/A

Class W

   []       []%   N/A

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund) (Current and Pro Forma)

    

Class A

   []       []%   []%

Class B

   []       []%   []%

Class C

   []       []%   []%

Class I

   []       []%   []%

Class R

   []       []%   []%

Class R4

   []       []%   []%

Class W

   []       []%   []%

Class Y

   []       []%   []%

Class Z

   []       []%   []%

 

* Class R shares of Seligman Capital Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund and Seligman Growth Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

 

-109-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights

The financial highlights tables below are designed to help you understand how each Buying Fund has performed for the past five full fiscal years or, if shorter, the Buying Fund’s period of operations. Certain information reflects financial results for a single Buying Fund share. The total return line indicates how much an investment in the Buying Fund would have earned each period assuming any dividends and distributions had been reinvested. The information shown below for each Buying Fund has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, whose report, along with the Fund’s financial statements, is included in each Buying Fund’s annual report to shareholders. The information shown for the six-month period ended March 31, 2010 for Columbia Contrarian Core Fund and Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, February 28, 2010 for Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, and for the one year period ended August 31, 2010 for Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund is unaudited. The independent registered public accounting firm’s reports and the Buying Funds’ financial statements are also incorporated by reference into the Merger SAI.

Because Class I shares of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Class I shares of Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Class I and Class I shares of Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I, Class I and Class R of Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and Class I and Class W shares of Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund are new, and because Class R4 shares of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Class R5 shares of Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Class R4 and Class R5 shares of Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and Class R4 shares of Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund have not yet commenced operations, no financial highlights are provided for these share classes.

 

-110-


Table of Contents

 

Table D-3. Financial Highlights of Buying Funds [[Financial Highlights to be added for T40 ]]

Financial Highlights - Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class A Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months  Ended
March 31, 2010
    Year Ended
September 30,
2009(a)
    Year Ended
September 30,
2008
    Year Ended
September 30,
2007
    Year Ended
September 30,
2006
    Year Ended
September 30,
2005(b)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.76      $ 11.89      $ 15.51      $ 14.03      $ 13.59      $ 12.01   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment income (c)

     0.01        0.08        0.07        0.05        —   (d)      0.07 (e) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     1.32        (0.14     (2.17     2.60        1.21        1.93   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     1.33        (0.06     (2.10     2.65        1.21        2.00   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net investment income

     (0.06     (0.07     (0.05     —          (0.01     (0.07

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.47     (1.17     (0.76     (0.35
                                                

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.06     (0.07     (1.52     (1.17     (0.77     (0.42

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (d)      —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 13.03      $ 11.76      $ 11.89      $ 15.51      $ 14.03      $ 13.59   

Total return (f)(g)

     11.34 %(h)      (0.28 )%      (15.35 )%      19.82     9.24     16.98

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.19 %(i)(j)      1.17 %(i)      1.14 %(k)      1.14 %(i)      1.14 %(i)      1.14 %(i) 

Interest expense

     —          %(l)      %(l)      —          —          —     

Net expenses

     1.19 %(i)(j)      1.17 %(i)      1.14 %(k)      1.14 %(i)      1.14 %(i)      1.24 %(i) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.03 %(j)      0.11     0.10     0.10     0.12     0.09

Net investment income

     0.20 %(i)(j)      0.77 %(i)      0.53 %(k)      0.32 %(i)      %(i)(l)      0.59 %(i) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     28 %(h)      131     106     88     63     105

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 66,115      $ 27,742      $ 11,187      $ 12,054      $ 10,578      $ 10,393   

 

(a) On November 14, 2008, the Columbia Common Stock Fund was renamed the Columbia Contrarian Core Fund.
(b) On September 23, 2005, the Columbia Large Cap Core Fund was renamed the Columbia Common Stock Fund.
(c) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(d) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(e) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.05 per share.
(f) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(g) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(h) Not annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(j) Annualized.
(k) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(l) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-111-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class B Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months Ended
March 31,

2010
    Year Ended
September 30,
2009(a)
    Year Ended
September 30,
2008
    Year Ended
September 30,
2007
    Year Ended
September 30,
2006
    Year Ended
September 30,
2005(b)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.02      $ 11.14      $ 14.67      $ 13.42      $ 13.12      $ 11.68   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment income (loss) (c)

     (0.03     0.01        (0.03     (0.06     (0.10     (0.04 ) (d) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     1.23        (0.13     (2.03     2.48        1.16        1.88   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     1.20        (0.12     (2.06     2.42        1.06        1.84   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net investment income

     —          —          —          —          —          (0.05

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.47     (1.17     (0.76     (0.35
                                                

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          —          (1.47     (1.17     (0.76     (0.40

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (e)      —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 12.22      $ 11.02      $ 11.14      $ 14.67      $ 13.42      $ 13.12   

Total return (f)(g)

     10.89 %(h)      (1.08 )%      (15.96 )%      18.94     8.40     16.02

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.94 %(i)(j)      1.92 %(i)      1.89 %(k)      1.89 %(i)      1.89 %(i)      1.99 %(i) 

Interest expense

     —          %(l)      %(l)      —          —          —     

Net expenses

     1.94 %(i)(j)      1.92 %(i)      1.89 %(k)      1.89 %(i)      1.89 %(i)      1.99 %(i) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.03 %(j)      0.11     0.10     0.10     0.12     0.09

Net investment income (loss)

     (0.54 )%(i)(j)      0.12 %(i)      (0.22 )%(k)      (0.44 )%(i)      (0.75 )%(i)      (0.31 )%(i) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     28 %(h)      131     106     88     63     105

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 4,379      $ 3,428      $ 3,629      $ 4,796      $ 5,637      $ 6,628   

 

(a) On November 14, 2008, the Columbia Common Stock Fund was renamed the Columbia Contrarian Core Fund.
(b) On September 23, 2005, the Columbia Large Cap Core Fund was renamed the Columbia Common Stock Fund.
(c) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(d) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.05 per share.
(e) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(f) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(g) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(h) Not annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(j) Annualized.
(k) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(l) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-112-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class C Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Six Months Ended
March 31,

2010
    Year Ended
September 30,
2009(a)
    Year Ended
September 30,
2008
    Year Ended
September 30,
2007
    Year Ended
September 30,
2006
    Year Ended
September 30,
2005(b)
 
Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period    $ 11.03      $ 11.15      $ 14.68      $ 13.43      $ 13.13      $ 11.68   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment income (loss) (c)

     (0.03     0.01        (0.03     (0.06     (0.10     (0.03 ) (d) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     1.24        (0.13     (2.03     2.48        1.16        1.88   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     1.21        (0.12     (2.06     2.42        1.06        1.85   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net investment income

     —          —          —          —          —          (0.05

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.47     (1.17     (0.76     (0.35
                                                

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          —          (1.47     (1.17     (0.76     (0.40

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (e)      —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 12.24      $ 11.03      $ 11.15      $ 14.68      $ 13.43      $ 13.13   

Total return (f)(g)

    
 
10.97
 
  
%(h) 
    (1.08 )%      (15.95 )%      18.93     8.40     16.10

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.94 %(i)(j)      1.92 %(i)      1.89 %(k)      1.89 %(i)      1.89 %(i)      1.99 %(i) 

Interest expense

     —          —   %(l)      —   %(l)      —          —          —     

Net expenses

     1.94 %(i)(j)      1.92 %(i)      1.89 %(k)      1.89 %(i)      1.89 %(i)      1.99 %(i) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.03 %(j)      0.11     0.10     0.10     0.12     0.09

Net investment income (loss)

     (0.54 )%(i)(j)      0.03 %(i)      (0.21 )%(k)      (0.41 )%(i)      (0.75 )%(i)      (0.25 )%(i) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     28 %(h)      131     106     88     63     105

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 14,493      $ 7,094      $ 1,718      $ 1,428      $ 906      $ 605   

 

(a) On November 14, 2008, the Columbia Common Stock Fund was renamed the Columbia Contrarian Core Fund.
(b) On September 23, 2005, the Columbia Large Cap Core Fund was renamed the Columbia Common Stock Fund.
(c) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(d) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.05 per share.
(e) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(f) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(g) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(h) Not annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(j) Annualized.
(k) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(l) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-113-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

 

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

 

Class A Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 
Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period    $ 17.58      $ 23.47      $ 27.51      $ 24.01      $ 22.16   
Income from Investment Operations:           

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.10     (0.03     (0.12     (0.01 ) (b)      (0.10

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.74        (5.37     (0.06     4.97        2.26   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.64        (5.40     (0.18     4.96        2.16   
Less Distributions to Shareholders:           

From net realized gains

     —          (0.49     (3.86     (1.46     (0.31
Increase from regulatory settlements      —          —   (c)      —          —          —     
Net Asset Value, End of Period    $ 20.22      $ 17.58      $ 23.47      $ 27.51      $ 24.01   

Total return(d)

     15.02     (22.38 )%      (2.21 )%      21.24     9.76  %(e) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(f)

     1.23     1.26     1.18     1.17     1.21

Interest expense

     —   %(g)      —          —   %(g)      —   %(g)      —     

Net expenses(f)

     1.23     1.26     1.18     1.17     1.21

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          0.01

Net investment loss(f)

     (0.49 )%      (0.20 )%      (0.48 )%      (0.05 )%      (0.43 )% 

Portfolio turnover rate

     137     160     149     171     67

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 65,123      $ 53,881      $ 63,337      $ 49,614      $ 12,654   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects special dividends. The effect of these dividends amounted to $0.07 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(e) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(g) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-114-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class B Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Year  Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 
Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period    $ 16.59      $ 22.35      $ 26.47      $ 23.32      $ 21.69   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.23     (0.14     (0.30     (0.20 ) (b)      (0.28

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.57        (5.13     (0.04     4.81        2.22   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.34        (5.27     (0.34     4.61        1.94   
Less Distributions to Shareholders:           

From net realized gains

     —          (0.49     (3.78     (1.46     (0.31

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (c)      —          —          —     
Net Asset Value, End of Period    $ 18.93      $ 16.59      $ 22.35      $ 26.47      $ 23.32   

Total return(d)

     14.10     (22.93 )%      (2.92 )%      20.33     8.95  %(e) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(f)

     1.98     2.01     1.93     1.92     1.96

Interest expense

     —   %(g)      —          —   %(g)      —   %(g)      —     

Net expenses(f)

     1.98     2.01     1.93     1.92     1.96

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          0.01

Net investment loss(f)

     (1.24 )%      (0.95 )%      (1.23 )%      (0.79 )%      (1.19 )% 

Portfolio turnover rate

     137     160     149     171     67

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 5,582      $ 8,322      $ 15,829      $ 19,472      $ 7,452   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects special dividends. The effect of these dividends amounted to $0.07 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(e) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(g) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-115-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class C Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 
Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period    $ 16.63      $ 22.41      $ 26.53      $ 23.37      $ 21.74   
Income from Investment Operations:           

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.24     (0.14     (0.30     (0.21 ) (b)      (0.28

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.59        (5.15     (0.04     4.83        2.22   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.35        (5.29     (0.34     4.62        1.94   
Less Distributions to Shareholders:           

From net realized gains

     —          (0.49     (3.78     (1.46     (0.31

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (c)      —          —          —     
Net Asset Value, End of Period    $ 18.98      $ 16.63      $ 22.41      $ 26.53      $ 23.37   

Total return(d)

     14.13     (22.96 )%      (2.91 )%      20.33     8.93  %(e) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(f)

     1.98     2.01     1.93     1.92     1.96

Interest expense

     —   %(g)      —          —   %(g)      —   %(g)      —  

Net expenses(f)

     1.98     2.01     1.93     1.92     1.96

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          0.01

Net investment loss(f)

     (1.24 )%      (0.95 )%      (1.23 )%      (0.81 )%      (1.16 )% 

Portfolio turnover rate

     137     160     149     171     67

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 9,858      $ 9,106      $ 13,540      $ 8,237      $ 2,454   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects special dividends. The effect of these dividends amounted to $0.07 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(e) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(g) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-116-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class R Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Period Ended
August 31,
2006(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 17.42      $ 23.32      $ 27.39      $ 23.97      $ 24.44   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(b)

     (0.15     (0.07     (0.18     (0.15 ) (c)      (0.10

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.71        (5.34     (0.06     5.03        (0.37
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.56        (5.41     (0.24     4.88        (0.47
Less Distributions to Shareholders:           

From net realized gains

     —          (0.49     (3.83     (1.46     —     

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (d)      —          —          —     
Net Asset Value, End of Period    $ 19.98      $ 17.42      $ 23.32      $ 27.39      $ 23.97   

Total return(e)

     14.70     (22.57 )%      (2.44 )%      20.93     (1.92 )%(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets / Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest
expense(g)

     1.48     1.51     1.43     1.42     1.47 %(h) 

Interest expense

     —   %(i)      —          —   %(i)      —   %(i)      —     

Net expenses(g)

     1.48     1.51     1.43     1.42     1.47 %(h) 

Net investment loss(g)

     (0.73 )%      (0.45 )%      (0.74 )%      (0.57 )%      (0.66 )%(h) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     137     160     149     171     67 %(f) 

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 5,112      $ 3,876      $ 1,800      $ 908      $ 57   

 

(a) Class R shares were initially offered on January 23, 2006. Total return reflects activity from that date.
(b) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(c) Net investment income per share reflects special dividends. The effect of these dividends amounted to $0.07 per share.
(d) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(e) Total return at net assets value assuming all distributions reinvested.
(f) Not annualized.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-117-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights – Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class A Shares

 

      Year Ended
June 30,
2010
    Year Ended
June 30,
2009
    Year Ended
June 30,
2008
    Year Ended
June 30,
2007
    Year Ended
June 30,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 29.29      $ 39.50      $ 52.16      $ 48.03      $ 43.12   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment income(a)

     0.15        0.23 (b)      0.15        0.12 (c)      0.06   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     6.58        (8.50     (8.46     7.61        6.82   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     6.73        (8.27     (8.31     7.73        6.88   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.18     (0.01     (0.14     (0.01     —     

From net realized gains

     —          (1.93     (4.21     (3.59     (1.97
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.18     (1.94     (4.35     (3.60     (1.97

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (d)      —   (d)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 35.84      $ 29.29      $ 39.50      $ 52.16      $ 48.03   

Total return(e)

     22.99     (20.73 )%      (16.96 )%      16.61     16.25 %(f) (g) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(h)

     1.27     1.38     1.26     1.29     1.28

Interest expense(i)

     —       —       —       —       —  

Net expenses(h)

     1.27     1.38     1.26     1.29     1.28

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          0.01

Net investment income(h)

     0.43     0.74     0.29     0.25     0.13

Portfolio turnover rate

     30     50     40     39     32

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 593,209      $ 443,154      $ 513,671      $ 663,160      $ 505,971   

See accompanying Notes to Financial Highlights

 

-118-


Table of Contents

Financial Highlights – Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class B Shares

 

      Year Ended
June 30,
2010
    Year Ended
June 30,
2009
    Year Ended
June 30,
2008
    Year Ended
June 30,
2007
    Year Ended
June 30,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 23.96      $ 33.00      $ 44.51      $ 41.75      $ 38.00   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.10     (0.01 ) (b)      (0.21     (0.24 ) (c)      (0.26

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     5.38        (7.10     (7.09     6.59        5.98   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     5.28        (7.11     (7.30     6.35        5.72   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.07     —          —          —          —     

From net realized gains

     —          (1.93     (4.21     (3.59     (1.97
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.07     (1.93     (4.21     (3.59     (1.97

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (d)      —   (d)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 29.17      $ 23.96      $ 33.00      $ 44.51      $ 41.75   

Total return(e)

     22.02     (21.31 )%      (17.58 )%      15.74     15.36 %(f) (g) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(h)

     2.02     2.13     2.01     2.04     2.03

Interest expense(i)

     —       —       —       —       —  

Net expenses(h)

     2.02     2.13     2.01     2.04     2.03

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          0.01

Net investment loss(h)

     (0.33 )%      (0.02 )%      (0.47 )%      (0.55 )%      (0.64 )% 

Portfolio turnover rate

     30     50     40     39     32

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 22,775      $ 28,977      $ 50,784      $ 97,425      $ 135,721   

See accompanying Notes to Financial Highlights

 

-119-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights – Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class C Shares

 

      Year Ended
June 30,
2010
    Year Ended
June 30,
2009
    Year Ended
June 30,
2008
    Year Ended
June 30,
2007
    Year Ended
June 30,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 25.35      $ 34.76      $ 46.65      $ 43.60      $ 39.60   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment income (loss)(a)

     (0.10     —   (b)(c)      (0.22     (0.23 )(d)      (0.26

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     5.69        (7.48     (7.46     6.87        6.23   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     5.59        (7.48     (7.68     6.64        5.97   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.07     —          —          —          —     

From net realized gains

     —          (1.93     (4.21     (3.59     (1.97
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.07     (1.93     (4.21     (3.59     (1.97

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (c)      —   (c)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 30.87      $ 25.35      $ 34.76      $ 46.65      $ 43.60   

Total return(e)

     22.04     (21.30 )%      (17.59 )%      15.74     15.37   

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(h)

     2.02     2.13     2.01     2.04     2.03   

Interest expense(i)

     —       —       —       —       —     

Net expenses(h)

     2.02     2.13     2.01     2.04     2.03   

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          0.01   

Net investment loss(h)

     (0.33 )%      (0.01 )%      (0.47 )%      (0.51 )%      (0.62

Portfolio turnover rate

     30     50     40     39     32   

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 49,888      $ 44,377      $ 61,053      $ 87,642      $ 68,436   

See accompanying Notes to Financial Highlights

 

Notes to Financial Highlights

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects special dividends. The effect of these dividends amounted to $0.03 per share.
(c) Net investment income per share reflects special dividends. The effect of these dividends amounted to $0.05 per share.
(d) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(e) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(f) Total return includes a voluntary reimbursement by the investment advisor for a realized investment loss due to a trading error. This reimbursement increased total return and net asset value per share by less than 0.01% and less than $0.01, respectively.
(g) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(h) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(i) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

Class A Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
March 31,
2010
    Year Ended September 30,  
     2009     2008     2007     2006     2005  

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 18.77      $ 19.57      $ 26.76      $ 22.27      $ 21.11      $ 18.57   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment income(a)

     0.02        0.07        0.01        0.02        0.01        0.05 (b) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments

     1.99        (0.86     (5.40     4.87        1.19        2.51   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     2.01        (0.79     (5.39     4.89        1.20        2.56   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net investment income

     (0.09     (0.02     —          (0.03     (0.04     (0.02

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.81     (0.37     —          —     
                                                

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.09     (0.02     (1.81     (0.40     (0.04     (0.02

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (c)      0.01        0.01        —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 20.69      $ 18.77      $ 19.57      $ 26.76      $ 22.27      $ 21.11   

Total return(d)

     10.75 %(e)      (3.97 )%      (21.73 )%      22.19     5.69 %(f)      13.80 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.10 %(h)      1.13 %(g)      1.02 %(i)      1.00 %(g)      1.01 %(g)      1.11 %(g) 

Interest expense

     %(h)(j)      —   %(j)      —          —   %(j)      —   %(j)      —     

Net expenses

     1.10 %(h)      1.13 %(g)      1.02 %(i)      1.00 %(g)      1.01 %(g)      1.11 %(g) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          —   %(j)      —   %(j) 

Net investment income

     0.25 %(h)      0.43 %(g)      0.01 %(i)      0.07 %(g)      0.07 %(g)      0.25 %(g) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     61 %(e)      146     164     151     171     113

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 157,853      $ 145,825      $ 156,585      $ 167,408      $ 125,124      $ 10,422   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.09 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(e) Not annualized.
(f) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(j) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

Class B Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
March 31,
2010
    Year Ended September 30,  
     2009     2008     2007     2006     2005  

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 17.30      $ 18.15      $ 25.12      $ 21.05      $ 20.07      $ 17.76   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.05     (0.04     (0.17     (0.16     (0.13     (0.09 )(b) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments

     1.83        (0.82     (5.00     4.60        1.11        2.402.31   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     1.78        (0.86     (5.17     4.44        0.98     

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.81     (0.37     —          —     

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (c)      0.01        0.01        —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 19.08      $ 17.30      $ 18.15      $ 25.12      $ 21.05      $ 20.07   

Total return(d)

     10.29 %(e)      (4.68 )%      (22.31 )%      21.31     4.88 %(f)      13.01 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.85 %(h)      1.88 %(g)      1.77 %(i)      1.75 %(g)      1.76 %(g)      1.86 %(g) 

Interest expense

     %(h)(j)      —   %(j)      —          —   %(j)      —   %(j)      —     

Net expenses

     1.85 %(h)      1.88 %(g)      1.77 %(i)      1.75 %(g)      1.76 %(g)      1.86 %(g) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          —   %(j)      —   %(j) 

Net investment loss

     (0.51 )%(h)      (0.30 )%(g)      (0.77 )%(i)      (0.69 )%(g)      (0.72 )%(g)      (0.48 )%(g) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     61 %(e)      146     164     151     171     113

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 19,717      $ 24,951      $ 58,609      $ 168,284      $ 227,160      $ 7,799   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.09 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(e) Not annualized.
(f) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(j) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

Class C Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
March 31,
2010
    Year Ended September 30,  
     2009     2008     2007     2006     2005  

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 17.31      $ 18.16      $ 25.14      $ 21.06      $ 20.10      $ 17.79   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.05     (0.05     (0.16     (0.16     (0.13     (0.09 )(b) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments

     1.84        (0.81     (5.02     4.61        1.09        2.40   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     1.79        (0.86     (5.18     4.45        0.96        2.31   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.81     (0.37     —          —     

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (c)      0.01        0.01        —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 19.10      $ 17.31      $ 18.16      $ 25.14      $ 21.06      $ 20.10   

Total return(d)

     10.34 %(e)      (4.68 )%      (22.33 )%      21.34     4.78 %(f)      12.98 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.85 %(h)      1.88 %(g)      1.77 %(i)      1.75 %(g)      1.76 %(g)      1.86 %(g) 

Interest expense

     %(h)(j)      —   %(j)      —          —   %(j)      —   %(j)      —     

Net expenses

     1.85 %(h)      1.88 %(g)      1.77 %(i)      1.75 %(g)      1.76 %(g)      1.86 %(g) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          —   %(j)      —   %(j) 

Net investment loss

     (0.50 )%(h)      (0.33 )%(g)      (0.75 )%(i)      (0.68 )%(g)      (0.69 )%(g)      (0.45 )%(g) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     61 %(e)      146     164     151     171     113

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 17,502      $ 17,283      $ 21,208      $ 31,834      $ 31,046      $ 1,419   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.09 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(e) Not annualized.
(f) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(j) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

Class Z Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
March 31,
2010
    Year Ended September 30,  
     2009     2008     2007     2006     2005  

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 19.20      $ 20.02      $ 27.32      $ 22.68      $ 21.50      $ 18.87   

Income from Investment Operations:

            

Net investment
income(a)

     0.05        0.11        0.06        0.08        0.08        0.11 (b) 

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments

     2.03        (0.88     (5.51     4.97        1.19        2.55   
                                                

Total from investment operations

     2.08        (0.77     (5.45     5.05        1.27        2.66   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

            

From net investment income

     (0.13     (0.06     (0.05     (0.04     (0.09     (0.03

From net realized gains

     —          —          (1.81     (0.37     —          —     
                                                

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.13     (0.06     (1.86     (0.41     (0.09     (0.03

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (c)      0.01        0.01        —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 21.15      $ 19.20      $ 20.02      $ 27.32      $ 22.68      $ 21.50   

Total return(d)

     10.90 %(e)      (3.71 )%      (21.55 )%      22.53     5.92 %(f)      14.12 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

            

Net expenses before interest expense

     0.85 %(h)      0.88 %(g)      0.77 %(i)      0.75 %(g)      0.76 %(g)      0.86 %(g) 

Interest expense

     %(h)(j)      —   %(j)      —          —   %(j)      —   %(j)      —     

Net expenses

     0.85 %(h)      0.88 %(g)      0.77 %(i)      0.75 %(g)      0.76 %(g)      0.86 %(g) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —          —          —          —   %(j)      —   %(j) 

Net investment income

     0.50 %(h)      0.67 %(g)      0.25 %(i)      0.32 %(g)      0.35 %(g)      0.53 %(g) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     61 %(e)      146     164     151     171     113

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 951,322      $ 940,823      $ 979,353      $ 1,302,932      $ 1,169,103      $ 1,242,736   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.09 per share.
(c) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(d) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested.
(e) Not annualized.
(f) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.01%.
(j) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-120-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class A Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Six Months Ended
August 31,

2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Year Ended
February 29,
2008
    Period Ended
February 28,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(b)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.18      $ 6.87      $ 13.12      $ 15.21      $ 15.01      $ 14.02      $ 12.77   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment income(c)

     0.10 (d)      0.07        0.11        0.13        0.10        0.11        0.13   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.48     4.32        (6.25     (1.19     1.67        2.47        2.23 (e) 
                                                        

Total from investment operations

     (0.38     4.39        (6.14     (1.06     1.77        2.58        2.36   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     (0.01     (0.07     (0.10     (0.16     (0.06     (0.07     (0.12

From net realized gains

     —          —          —          (0.87     (1.51     (1.52     (1.00

From return of capital

     —          (0.01     (0.01     —          —          —          —     
                                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.01     (0.08     (0.11     (1.03     (1.57     (1.59     (1.12

Increase due to capital contributions

     —          —          —          —          —          —          0.01   

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (f)      —   (f)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.79      $ 11.18      $ 6.87      $ 13.12      $ 15.21      $ 15.01      $ 14.02   

Total return(g)

     (3.38 )%(h)      64.09     (47.05 )%      (7.88 )%      13.09 %(h)      20.24     19.90 %(i) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense(j)

     1.14 %(k)      1.17     1.17     1.10     1.12 %(k)      1.08     1.20

Interest expense

     —          —          —          —          —          —          —   %(l) 

Net expenses(j)

     1.14 %(k)      1.17     1.17     1.10     1.12 %(k)      1.08     1.20

Net investment income(j)

     1.74 %(k)      0.71     0.97     0.83     0.76 %(k)      0.80     0.99

Portfolio turnover rate

     29 %(h)      56     46     24     53 %(h)      41     61

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 1,273,014      $ 1,441,388      $ 966,440      $ 1,677,414      $ 1,296,803      $ 874,429      $ 10,258   

 

(a) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 28. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2006 through February 28, 2007.
(b) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Investor A shares were renamed Class A shares.
(c) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(d) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.08 per share.
(e) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was to increase net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments by $0.01.
(f) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(g) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(h) Not annualized.
(i) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 19.81%.
(j) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(k) Annualized.
(l) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-121-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class B Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Six Months Ended
August 31,

2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Year Ended
February 29,
2008
    Period Ended
February 28,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(b)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 10.94      $ 6.73      $ 12.86      $ 14.94      $ 14.80      $ 13.89      $ 12.70   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment income (loss)(c)

     0.05 (d)      —   (e)      0.02        0.03        —   (e)      0.01        0.03   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.47     4.23        (6.11     (1.19     1.65        2.43        2.20 (f) 
                                                        

Total from investment operations

     (0.42     4.23        (6.09     (1.16     1.65        2.44        2.23   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     —          (0.02     (0.03     (0.05     —   (e)      (0.01     (0.05

From net realized gains

     —          —          —          (0.87     (1.51     (1.52     (1.00

From return of capital

     —          —   (e)      (0.01     —          —          —          —     
                                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          (0.02     (0.04     (0.92     (1.51     (1.53     (1.05

Increase due to capital contribution

     —          —          —          —          —          —          0.01   

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (e)      —   (e)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.52      $ 10.94      $ 6.73      $ 12.86      $ 14.94      $ 14.80      $ 13.89   

Total return(g)

     (3.84 )%(h)      62.86     (47.41 )%      (8.61 )%      12.36 %(h)      19.32     18.91 %(i) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense(j)

     1.89 %(k)      1.92     1.92     1.85     1.87 %(k)      1.84     1.95

Interest expense

     —          —          —          —          —          —          —   %(l) 

Net expenses(j)

     1.89 %(k)      1.92     1.92     1.85     1.87 %(k)      1.84     1.95

Net investment income (loss)(j)

     0.84 %(k)      (0.01 )%      0.18     0.18     (0.02 )%(k)      0.05     0.24

Portfolio turnover rate

     29 %(h)      56     46     24     53 %(h)      41     61

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 45,707      $ 68,110      $ 66,254      $ 179,087      $ 255,123      $ 312,587      $ 4,447   

 

(a) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 28. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2006 through February 28, 2007.
(b) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Investor B shares were renamed Class B shares.
(c) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(d) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.08 per share.
(e) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(f) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was to increase net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments by $0.01.
(g) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(h) Not annualized.
(i) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 18.82%.
(j) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(k) Annualized.
(l) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-122-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights - Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class C Shares

 

      (Unaudited)
Six Months Ended
August 31,

2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Year Ended
February 29,
2008
    Period Ended
February 28,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(b)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 10.98      $ 6.75      $ 12.90      $ 14.99      $ 14.84      $ 13.93      $ 12.73   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment income (loss)(c)

     0.06 (d)      —   (e)      0.02        0.01        —   (e)      0.01        0.05   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.48     4.25        (6.13     (1.18     1.66        2.43        2.19 (f) 
                                                        

Total from investment operations

     (0.42     4.25        (6.11     (1.17     1.66        2.44        2.24   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     —          (0.02     (0.03     (0.05     —   (e)      (0.01     (0.05

From net realized gains

     —          —          —          (0.87     (1.51     (1.52     (1.00

From return of capital

     —          —   (e)      (0.01     —          —          —          —     
                                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          (0.02     (0.04     (0.92     (1.51     (1.53     (1.05

Increase due to capital contributions

     —          —          —          —          —          —          0.01   

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —   (e)      —   (e)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.56      $ 10.98      $ 6.75      $ 12.90      $ 14.99      $ 14.84      $ 13.93   

Total return(g)

     (3.83 )%(h)      62.97     (47.42 )%      (8.65 )%      12.40 %(h)      19.25     18.97 %(i) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense(j)

     1.89 %(k)      1.92     1.92     1.85     1.87 %(k)      1.84     1.95

Interest expense

     —          —          —          —          —          —          —   %(l) 

Net expenses(j)

     1.89 %(k)      1.92     1.92     1.85     1.87 %(k)      1.84     1.95

Net investment income (loss)(j)

     0.97 %(k)      (0.03 )%      0.19     0.07     0.03 %(k)      0.05     0.36

Portfolio turnover rate

     29 %(h)      56     46     24     53 %(h)      41     61

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 151,738      $ 181,941      $ 144,370      $ 318,190      $ 249,067      $ 123,789      $ 944   

 

(a) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 28. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2006 through February 28, 2007.
(b) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Investor C shares were renamed Class C shares.
(c) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(d) Net investment income per share reflects a special dividend. The effect of this dividend amounted to $0.08 per share.
(e) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(f) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was to increase net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments by $0.01.
(g) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(h) Not annualized.
(i) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 18.88%.
(j) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(k) Annualized.
(l) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-123-


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit A

Costs of the Reorganizations

Each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund may bear a portion of the out-of-pocket expenses associated with its Reorganization. Out-of-pocket expenses associated with a Reorganization include, but are not limited to: (1) the expenses associated with the preparation, printing and mailing of any shareholder communications, including this proxy statement/prospectus, and any filings with the SEC and/or other governmental authorities in connection with the Reorganization; (2) the fees and expenses of any proxy solicitation firm retained in connection with the Reorganization; and (3) the legal and other fees and expenses incurred in connection with the Reorganization. Class I and Class R of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund are not expected to benefit from expense savings as a result of the Reorganization, but they nevertheless will bear a proportionate share of any Reorganization expenses allocated to the Fund.

All fees paid to governmental authorities for the registration or qualification of the Buying Fund shares to be issued in the Reorganization and all transfer agency costs related to such shares will be allocated to the Buying Fund. All fees and expenses related to printing and mailing communications to Selling Fund shareholders will be allocated to the Selling Fund. All of the other out-of-pocket expenses of a Reorganization, including without limitation, accounting, legal and custodial expenses, will be allocated equally among the applicable Funds. Following this initial allocation between the Funds, Columbia Management limits the expenses actually borne by a Fund to the anticipated reduction in expenses to be incurred by that Fund over the first year following the Reorganization. Any reduction in the Reorganization expenses borne by a Fund as a result of this limitation is absorbed by Columbia Management, not by any other Fund. The estimated costs of each Reorganization expected to be borne by each Selling Fund and the Buying Fund, in the aggregate and on a per-share basis based on shares outstanding as of August 31, 2010, are set forth below:

 

     Costs Estimated to be Borne  

Fund

   Total      Per Share  

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 85,372       $ 0.001   

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 143,752       $ 0.013   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 21,654       $ 0.004   

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 731,740       $ 0.002   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 133,761       $ 0.007   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 12,246       $ 0.000   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 0       $ 0.000   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I (Buying Fund)

   $ 0       $ 0.000   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 0       $ 0.000   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 0       $ 0.000   

Should any Reorganization fail to occur, Columbia Management will bear all costs associated with that Reorganization.

Based on the operating expense ratios shown in the Fees and Expenses section above for each Buying Fund, it is projected that, after the Reorganizations, assuming all of the Reorganizations are consummated, each class of each Selling Fund will benefit from expense savings that will offset the allocated Reorganization expenses. However, the benefit of those projected expense savings will not be realized immediately. It is projected that the aggregate expense savings for the Selling Funds will not exceed the allocated Reorganization expenses of each Selling Fund until approximately the number of months after its Reorganization set forth below.

 

Fund

   Number of Months

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

   12

Seligman Capital Fund

   6

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

   8

Seligman Growth Fund

   4

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

   7

If a shareholder redeems his or her shares prior to the indicated time, the shareholder will receive no net benefit from the projected expense savings.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

Exhibit B

Minnesota Business Corporation Act Sections 302A.471 and 302A.473

If you are a shareholder of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund or RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, Minnesota law requires that we provide you with a copy of the state law on dissenters’ rights. Notwithstanding the provisions of the law set out below, the SEC has taken the position that use of state appraisal procedures by a registered mutual fund would be a violation of Rule 22c-1, the forward pricing rule, under the 1940 Act. As a result, if any shareholder elects to exercise dissenters’ rights under Minnesota law, the applicable Selling Fund intends to submit this question to a court of competent jurisdiction. In that event, a dissenting shareholder would not receive any payment until the end of the court proceeding.

302A.471. Rights of dissenting shareholders

Subdivision 1. Actions creating rights. A shareholder of a corporation may dissent from, and obtain payment for the fair value of the shareholder’s shares in the event of, any of the following corporate actions:

 

(a) unless otherwise provided in the articles, an amendment of the articles that materially and adversely affects the rights or preferences of the shares of the dissenting shareholder in that it:

 

(1) alters or abolishes a preferential right of the shares;

 

(2) creates, alters, or abolishes a right in respect of the redemption of the shares, including a provision respecting a sinking fund for the redemption or repurchase of the shares;

 

(3) alters or abolishes a preemptive right of the holder of the shares to acquire shares, securities other than shares, or rights to purchase shares or securities other than shares;

 

(4) excludes or limits the right of a shareholder to vote on a matter, or to cumulate votes, except as the right may be excluded or limited through the authorization or issuance of securities of an existing or new class or series with similar or different voting rights; except that an amendment to the articles of an issuing public corporation that provides that section 302A.671 does not apply to a control share acquisition does not give rise to the right to obtain payment under this section;

 

(5) eliminates the right to obtain payment under this subdivision;

 

(b) a sale, lease, transfer, or other disposition of property and assets of the corporation that requires shareholder approval under section 302A.661, subdivision 2, but not including a disposition in dissolution described in section 302A.725, subdivision 2, or a disposition pursuant to an order of a court, or a disposition for cash on terms requiring that all or substantially all of the net proceeds of disposition be distributed to the shareholders in accordance with their respective interests within one year after the date of disposition;

 

(c) a plan of merger, whether under this chapter or under chapter 322B, to which the corporation is a constituent organization, except as provided in subdivision 3, and except for a plan of merger adopted under section 302A.626;

 

(d) a plan of exchange, whether under this chapter or under chapter 322B, to which the corporation is a party as the corporation whose shares will be acquired by the acquiring organization, except as provided in subdivision 3;

 

(e) a plan of conversion adopted by the corporation; or

 

(f) any other corporate action taken pursuant to a shareholder vote with respect to which the articles, the bylaws, or a resolution approved by the board directs that dissenting shareholders may obtain payment for their shares.

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Subdivision 2. Beneficial owners.

 

(a) A shareholder shall not assert dissenters’ rights as to less than all of the shares registered in the name of the shareholder, unless the shareholder dissents with respect to all the shares that are beneficially owned by another person but registered in the name of the shareholder and discloses the name and address of each beneficial owner on whose behalf the shareholder dissents. In that event, the rights of the dissenter shall be determined as if the shares as to which the shareholder has dissented and the other shares were registered in the names of different shareholders.

 

(b) A beneficial owner of shares who is not the shareholder may assert dissenters’ rights with respect to shares held on behalf of the beneficial owner, and shall be treated as a dissenting shareholder under the terms of this section and section 302A.473, if the beneficial owner submits to the corporation at the time of or before the assertion of the rights a written consent of the shareholder.

Subdivision 3. Rights not to apply.

 

(a) Unless the articles, the bylaws, or a resolution approved by the board otherwise provide, the right to obtain payment under this section does not apply to a shareholder of (1) the surviving corporation in a merger with respect to shares of the shareholder that are not entitled to be voted on the merger and are not canceled or exchanged in the merger or (2) the corporation whose shares will be acquired by the acquiring organization in a plan of exchange with respect to shares of the shareholder that are not entitled to be voted on the plan of exchange and are not exchanged in the plan of exchange.

 

(b) If a date is fixed according to section 302A.445, subdivision 1, for the determination of shareholders entitled to receive notice of and to vote on an action described in subdivision 1, only shareholders as of the date fixed, and beneficial owners as of the date fixed who hold through shareholders, as provided in subdivision 2, may exercise dissenters’ rights.

 

(c) Notwithstanding subdivision 1, the right to obtain payment under this section, other than in connection with a plan of merger adopted under section 302A.621, is limited in accordance with the following provisions:

 

(1) The right to obtain payment under this section is not available for the holders of shares of any class or series of shares that is listed on the New York Stock Exchange, the American Stock Exchange, the NASDAQ Global Market, or the NASDAQ Global Select Market.

 

(2) The applicability of clause (1) is determined as of:

 

(i) the record date fixed to determine the shareholders entitled to receive notice of, and to vote at, the meeting of shareholders to act upon the corporate action described in subdivision 1; or

 

(ii) the day before the effective date of corporate action described in subdivision 1 if there is no meeting of shareholders.

 

(3) Clause (1) is not applicable, and the right to obtain payment under this section is available pursuant to subdivision 1, for the holders of any class or series of shares who are required by the terms of the corporate action described in subdivision 1 to accept for such shares anything other than shares, or cash in lieu of fractional shares, of any class or any series of shares of a domestic or foreign corporation, or any other ownership interest of any other organization, that satisfies the standards set forth in clause (1) at the time the corporate action becomes effective.

Subdivision 4. Other rights. The shareholders of a corporation who have a right under this section to obtain payment for their shares, or who would have the right to obtain payment for their shares absent the exception set forth in paragraph (c) of subdivision 3, do not have a right at law or in equity to have a corporate action described in subdivision 1 set aside or rescinded, except when the corporate action is fraudulent with regard to the complaining shareholder or the corporation.

302A.473. Procedures for asserting dissenters’ rights

Subdivision 1. Definitions.

 

(a) For purposes of this section, the terms defined in this subdivision have the meanings given them.

 

B-2


Table of Contents

 

(b) “Corporation” means the issuer of the shares held by a dissenter before the corporate action referred to in section 302A.471, subdivision 1 or the successor by merger of that issuer.

 

(c) “Fair value of the shares” means the value of the shares of a corporation immediately before the effective date of the corporate action referred to in section 302A.471, subdivision 1.

 

(d) “Interest” means interest commencing five days after the effective date of the corporate action referred to in section 302A.471, subdivision 1, up to and including the date of payment, calculated at the rate provided in section 549.09 for interest on verdicts and judgments.

Subdivision 2. Notice of action. If a corporation calls a shareholder meeting at which any action described in section 302A.471, subdivision 1 is to be voted upon, the notice of the meeting shall inform each shareholder of the right to dissent and shall include a copy of section 302A.471 and this section and a brief description of the procedure to be followed under these sections.

Subdivision 3. Notice of dissent. If the proposed action must be approved by the shareholders and the corporation holds a shareholder meeting, a shareholder who is entitled to dissent under section 302A.471 and who wishes to exercise dissenters’ rights must file with the corporation before the vote on the proposed action a written notice of intent to demand the fair value of the shares owned by the shareholder and must not vote the shares in favor of the proposed action.

Subdivision 4. Notice of procedure; deposit of shares.

 

(a) After the proposed action has been approved by the board and, if necessary, the shareholders, the corporation shall send to (i) all shareholders who have complied with subdivision 3, (ii) all shareholders who did not sign or consent to a written action that gave effect to the action creating the right to obtain payment under section 302A.471, and (iii) all shareholders entitled to dissent if no shareholder vote was required, a notice that contains:

 

(1) the address to which a demand for payment and certificates of certificated shares must be sent in order to obtain payment and the date by which they must be received;

 

(2) any restrictions on transfer of uncertificated shares that will apply after the demand for payment is received;

 

(3) a form to be used to certify the date on which the shareholder, or the beneficial owner on whose behalf the shareholder dissents, acquired the shares or an interest in them and to demand payment; and

 

(4) a copy of section 302A.471 and this section and a brief description of the procedures to be followed under these sections.

 

(b) In order to receive the fair value of the shares, a dissenting shareholder must demand payment and deposit certificated shares or comply with any restrictions on transfer of uncertificated shares within 30 days after the notice required by paragraph (a) was given, but the dissenter retains all other rights of a shareholder until the proposed action takes effect.

Subdivision 5. Payment; return of shares.

 

(a) After the corporate action takes effect, or after the corporation receives a valid demand for payment, whichever is later, the corporation shall remit to each dissenting shareholder who has complied with subdivisions 3 and 4 the amount the corporation estimates to be the fair value of the shares, plus interest, accompanied by:

 

(1) the corporation’s closing balance sheet and statement of income for a fiscal year ending not more than 16 months before the effective date of the corporate action, together with the latest available interim financial statements;

 

(2) an estimate by the corporation of the fair value of the shares and a brief description of the method used to reach the estimate; and

 

(3) a copy of section 302A.471 and this section, and a brief description of the procedure to be followed in demanding supplemental payment.

 

B-3


Table of Contents

 

(b) The corporation may withhold the remittance described in paragraph (a) from a person who was not a shareholder on the date the action dissented from was first announced to the public or who is dissenting on behalf of a person who was not a beneficial owner on that date. If the dissenter has complied with subdivisions 3 and 4, the corporation shall forward to the dissenter the materials described in paragraph (a), a statement of the reason for withholding the remittance, and an offer to pay to the dissenter the amount listed in the materials if the dissenter agrees to accept that amount in full satisfaction. The dissenter may decline the offer and demand payment under subdivision 6. Failure to do so entitles the dissenter only to the amount offered. If the dissenter makes demand, subdivision 7 and 8 apply.

 

(c) If the corporation fails to remit payment within 60 days of the deposit of certificates or the imposition of transfer restrictions on uncertificated shares, it shall return all deposited certificates and cancel all transfer restrictions. However, the corporation may again give notice under subdivision 4 and require deposit or restrict transfer at a later time.

Subdivision 6. Supplemental payment; demand. If a dissenter believes that the amount remitted under subdivision 5 is less than the fair value of the shares plus interest, the dissenter may give written notice to the corporation of the dissenter’s own estimate of the fair value of the shares, plus interest, within 30 days after the corporation mails the remittance under subdivision 5, and demand payment of the difference. Otherwise, a dissenter is entitled only to the amount remitted by the corporation.

Subdivision 7. Petition; determination. If the corporation receives a demand under subdivision 6, it shall, within 60 days after receiving the demand, either pay to the dissenter the amount demanded or agreed to by the dissenter after discussion with the corporation or file in a court a petition requesting that the court determine the fair value of the shares, plus interest. The petition shall be filed in the county in which the registered office of the corporation is located, except that a surviving foreign corporation that receives a demand relating to the shares of a constituent domestic corporation shall file the petition in the county in this state in which the last registered office of the constituent corporation was located. The petition shall name as parties all dissenters who have demanded payment under subdivision 6 and who have not reached agreement with the corporation. The corporation shall, after filing the petition, serve all parties with a summons and copy of the petition under the rules of civil procedure. Nonresidents of this state may be served by registered or certified mail or by publication as provided by law. Except as otherwise provided, the rules of civil procedures apply to this proceeding. The jurisdiction of the court is plenary and exclusive. The court may appoint appraisers, with powers and authorities the court deems proper, to receive evidence on and recommend the amount of the fair value of the shares. The court shall determine whether the shareholder or shareholders in question have fully complied with the requirements of this section, and shall determine the fair value of the shares, taking into account any and all factors the court finds relevant, computed by any method or combination of methods that the court, in its discretion, sees fit to use, whether or not used by the corporation or by a dissenter. The fair value of the shares as determined by the court is binding on all shareholders, wherever located. A dissenter is entitled to judgment in cash for the amount by which the fair value of the shares as determined by the court, plus interest, exceeds the amount, if any, remitted under subdivision 5, but shall not be liable to the corporation for the amount, if any, by which the amount, if any, remitted to the dissenter under subdivision 5 exceeds the fair value of the shares as determined by the court, plus interest.

 

B-4


Table of Contents

 

Subdivision 8. Costs; fees; expenses.

 

(a) The court shall determine the costs and expenses of a proceeding under subdivision 7, including the reasonable expenses and compensation of any appraisers appointed by the court, and shall assess those costs and expenses against the corporation, except that the court may assess part or all of those costs and expenses against a dissenter whose action in demanding payment under subdivision 6 is found to be arbitrary, vexatious, or not in good faith.

 

(b) If the court finds that the corporation has failed to comply substantially with this section, the court may assess all fees and expenses of any experts or attorneys as the court deems equitable. These fees and expenses may also be assessed against a person who has acted arbitrarily, vexatiously, or not in good faith in bringing the proceeding, and may be awarded to a party injured by those actions.

 

(c) The court may award, in its discretion, fees and expenses to an attorney for the dissenters out of the amount awarded to the dissenters, if any.

 

B-5


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit C

Additional Information Applicable to the Buying Funds

Below is information regarding the Buying Funds. All references to a Fund or the Funds in this Exhibit C refer to a Buying Fund or the Buying Funds, respectively, unless otherwise noted.

Fund Management and Compensation (for all Buying Funds)

Columbia Management, 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the investment manager to the Combined Fund Complex (including the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Seligman- and Threadneedle- branded funds), and is a wholly owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial. In addition to managing investments for the Combined Fund Complex, Columbia Management manages investments for itself and its affiliates. For institutional clients, Columbia Management and its affiliates provide investment management and related services, such as separate account asset management and institutional trust and custody, as well as other investment products. For all of its clients, Columbia Management seeks to allocate investment opportunities in an equitable manner over time. See the Merger SAI for more information.

Subject to oversight by each Fund’s Board, Columbia Management manages the day-to-day operations of each Fund, determines what securities and other investments each Fund should buy or sell and executes the portfolio transactions. Although Columbia Management is responsible for the investment management of each Fund, Columbia Management may delegate certain of its duties to one or more investment subadvisers. Columbia Management may use the research and other capabilities of its affiliates and third parties in managing investments.

The Combined Fund Complex has received an order from the SEC that permits Columbia Management, subject to the approval of each Fund’s Board, to appoint a subadviser or change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for the Fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits the Fund to add or change unaffiliated subadvisers or change the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change. Columbia Management and its affiliates may have other relationships, including significant financial relationships, with current or potential subadvisers or their affiliates, which may create a conflict of interest. In making recommendations to each Fund’s Board to appoint or to change a subadviser, or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement, Columbia Management does not consider any other relationship it or its affiliates may have with a subadviser, and Columbia Management discloses to the Board the nature of any material relationships it has with a subadviser or its affiliates.

Each Fund pays Columbia Management a fee for managing its assets. The fees paid by each Buying Fund for the most recent fiscal year were the following percentage of each Buying Fund’s average daily net assets:

 

Buying Fund

   Percentage of Fund’s Average
Daily Net Assets

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

   0.70%

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

   0.79%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

   0.76%

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

   0.53%

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

   0.54%

Under its Investment Management Services Agreement (the “IMS Agreement”), each Buying Fund also pays taxes, brokerage commissions and nonadvisory expenses. A discussion regarding the basis for each Fund’s Board approving the IMS Agreement is available in the Columbia Contrarian Core Fund semiannual report for the period ended March 31, 2010; in the Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund semiannual report for the period ended February 28, 2010; in the Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I semiannual report for the period ended June 30,2010; in the Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund semiannual report for the period ended March 31, 2010; and in the Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund annual report for the period ended February 28, 2010.

Each Fund may from time to time take temporary defensive investment positions that are inconsistent with that Fund’s principal investment strategies in attempting to respond to adverse market, economic, political or other conditions including, for example, investments in money market instruments or holdings of cash or cash equivalents. Investing defensively may prevent a Fund from achieving its investment objective.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio Managers

Information about the portfolio managers who are primarily responsible for overseeing each Fund’s investments is shown below. The Merger SAI provides more information about each portfolio manager’s compensation, other accounts managed by each portfolio manager and each portfolio manager’s ownership of securities in each Fund.

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

The portfolio manager responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund is:

Guy W. Pope, CFA, Manager

 

 

Portfolio manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2005.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 1993.

 

 

Began investment career in 1993.

 

 

BS, Colorado College; MBA, Northwestern University.

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

The portfolio managers responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund are:

George J. Myers, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2004.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2004.

 

 

Began investment career in 1998.

 

 

BBA, MS (Finance), MS (Real Estate), University of Wisconsin.

Wayne M. Collette, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2006.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2001.

 

 

Began investment career in 1996.

 

 

BA, Brandeis University, MBA, Columbia Business School.

Lawrence W. Lin, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2007.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2006.

 

 

Worked as a research analyst at Primarius Capital in 2006 and at Engemann Asset Management from 1998 to 2006.

 

 

Began investment career in 1998.

 

 

BS, University of Southern California.

Brian D. Neigut, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2007.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2007.

 

 

Worked as a portfolio at Kern Capital Management LLC from 2006 to 2007 and at OppenheimerFunds Inc. from 2003 to 2006.

 

 

Began investment career in 1995.

 

 

BBA, Pacific Lutheran University.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

The portfolio managers responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund are:

Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA, Lead manager

 

 

Managing Director of the Advisor.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2002.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2002.

 

 

Began investment career in 1971.

 

 

BA, Brown Uniersity MBA, Columbia University.

Jeremy H. Javidi, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2005.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2005.

 

 

Began investment career in 2005.

 

 

BA, Tufts.

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

The portfolio managers responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund are:

John T. Wilson, CFA, Lead manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2005.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2005

 

 

Began investment career in 1985

 

 

BA, Trinity College, MBA, Duke University.

Peter R. Deininger, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since May 2010.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2002.

 

 

Began investment career in 1994.

 

 

BA, Dartmouth College, MBA, University of Chicago.

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

The portfolio managers responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund are:

David I. Hoffman, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2004.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2001.

 

 

Began investment career in 1986.

 

 

BA, Grinnell College; MA, Columbia University.

Diane L. Sobin, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2001.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2001.

 

 

Began investment career in 1983.

 

 

BBA, Pace University.

Lori J. Ensinger, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2001.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2001.

 

 

Began investment career in 1983.

 

 

BA, Williams College.

 

C-3


Table of Contents

 

Noah J. Petrucci, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Portfolio Manager of Columbia Management.

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2002.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors since 2002.

 

 

Began investment career in 1993.

 

 

BA, University of Massachusetts.

Legal Proceedings

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that each Fund is not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial or any of its affiliates is the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on each Fund or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with each Fund. Information regarding certain pending and settled legal proceedings may be found in each Fund’s shareholder reports and in the Merger SAI. Additionally, Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the SEC on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

Service Section

Choosing a Share Class

The Funds

Effective September 7, 2010, the Columbia funds (including the portfolios), Columbia Acorn funds and RiverSource funds (including the Seligman and Threadneedle branded funds) share the same policies and procedures for investor services, as described below. For example, for purposes of calculating the initial sales charge on the purchase of Class A shares of a fund, an investor or selling and/or servicing agent should consider the combined market value of all Columbia, Columbia Acorn, RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds owned by the investor or his/her “immediate family.” For details on this particular policy, see Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges – Front-End Sales Charge Reductions.

For purposes of this service section, funds and portfolios bearing the “Columbia” and “Columbia Acorn” brands prior to September 27, 2010 are collectively referred to as the Legacy Columbia funds. The Funds that historically bore the RiverSource brand, including those renamed to bear the “Columbia” brand effective September 27, 2010 as well as certain other funds are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds. Together the Legacy Columbia funds and the Legacy RiverSource funds are referred to as the Funds. References to the “Fund” are deemed to refer to one of the Funds or to one of the Buying Funds, as the context requires.

The Funds’ primary service providers are referred to as follows: Columbia Management or the investment manager refers to Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC), the Transfer Agent refers to Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly, RiverSource Services Corporation) and the Distributor refers to Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.).

Additional information about the Funds can be obtained at the Funds’ website, columbiamanagement.com, by calling toll-free 800.345.6611, or by writing (regular mail) to The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 or (express mail) The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809.

Comparison of Share Classes

Share Class Features

Not all Funds offer every class of shares. Each share class has its own investment eligibility criteria, cost structure and other features. You may not be eligible for every share class. If you purchase shares of the Fund through a retirement plan or other product or program sponsored by your selling and/or servicing agent, not all share classes may be made available to you.

The following summarizes the primary features of Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class T, Class W, Class Y and Class Z shares. Although Class B, Class E, Class F and Class T shares are generally closed to new and existing investors, information relating to these share classes is included in the table below because certain qualifying

 

C-4


Table of Contents

purchase orders are permitted, as described below. When deciding which class of shares to buy, you should consider, among other things:

 

 

The amount you plan to invest.

 

 

How long you intend to remain invested in the Fund.

 

 

The expenses for each share class.

 

 

Whether you may be eligible for a reduction or waiver of sales charges when you buy or sell shares.

FUNDamentalsTM

Selling and/or Servicing Agents

The terms “selling agent” and “servicing agent” refer to the financial intermediary that employs your financial advisor. Selling and/or servicing agents include, for example, brokerage firms, banks, investment advisors, third party administrators and other financial intermediaries.

Each investor’s personal situation is different and you may wish to discuss with your selling and/or servicing agent which share class is best for you. Your authorized selling and/or servicing agent can help you to determine which share class(es) is available to you and to decide which share class best meets your needs.

 

     

Eligible Investors and Minimum Initial
Investments(a)

  

Investment Limits

  

Conversion
Features

Class A*

   Available to the general public for investment; minimum initial investment is $2,000 for most investors.(e)    none    none

Class B*

   Closed to new investors.(h)    up to $49,999    Converts to Class A shares generally eight years after purchase.(i)

Class C*

   Available to the general public for investment; minimum initial investment is $2,000 for most investors.(e)    up to $999,999; no limit for eligible employee benefit plans.(j)    none

Class E

   Closed to new investors and new accounts.(k)    none    none

Class F

   Closed to new investors and new accounts.(k)    up to $250,000.(l)    Converts to Class E shares eight years after purchase.(i)

Class I*

   Available only to the Funds (i.e., Fund-of-Fund investments).    none    none

Class R*

   Available only to eligible retirement plans and health savings accounts; no minimum initial investment.    none    none

Class R3*

   Effective after the close of business on December 31, 2010, Class R3 shares are closed to new investors; available only to qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, 501(c)(3) charitable organizations, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, 529 plans, and health savings accounts.(n)    none    none

 

C-5


Table of Contents

 

     

Eligible Investors and Minimum Initial
Investments(a)

  

Investment Limits

  

Conversion
Features

Class R4*

   Effective after the close of business on December 31, 2010, Class R4 shares are closed to new investors; available only to qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, 501(c)(3) charitable organizations, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, 529 plans, and health savings accounts.(n)    none    none

Class R5*

   Effective after the close of business on December 31, 2010, Class R5 shares are closed to new investors; available only to qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, 501(c)(3) charitable organizations, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, 529 plans, health savings accounts and, if approved by the Distributor, institutional or corporate accounts above a threshold established by the Distributor (currently $1 million per Fund or $10 million in all Funds) and bank trust
departments.
(n)
   none    none

Class T

   Available only to investors who received (and who have continuously held) Class T shares in connection with the merger of certain Galaxy funds into various Columbia funds (formerly named Liberty funds).    none    none

Class W*

   Available only to investors purchasing through authorized investment programs managed by investment professionals, including discretionary managed account programs.    none    none

Class Y*

   Available to certain categories of investors which are subject to minimum initial investment requirements; currently offered only to former shareholders of the former Columbia Funds Institutional Trust.(q)    none    none

Class Z*

   Available only to certain eligible investors, which are subject to different minimum initial investment requirements, ranging from $0 to $2,000.    none    none

 

     

Front-End Sales Charges(b)

  

Contingent Deferred Sales Charges (CDSCs)(b)

Class A*

  

5.75% maximum, declining to 0.00% on investments of $1 million or more.

None for money market Funds and certain other Funds.(f)

   CDSC on certain investments of between $1 million and $50 million redeemed within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months of purchase.(g)

Class B*

   none    5.00% maximum, gradually declining to 0.00% after six years.(i)

Class C*

   none    1.00% on certain investments redeemed within one year of purchase.

Class E

   4.50% maximum, declining to 0.00% on investments of $500,000 or more.    1.00% on certain investments of between $1 million and $50 million redeemed within one year of purchase.

 

C-6


Table of Contents
     

Front-End Sales Charges(b)

  

Contingent Deferred Sales Charges (CDSCs)(b)

Class F

   none    5.00% maximum, gradually declining to 0.00% after six years.

Class I*

   none    none

Class R*

   none    none

Class R3*

   none    none

Class R4*

   none    none

Class R5*

   none    none

Class T

   5.75% maximum, declining to 0.00% on investments of $1 million or more.    CDSC on certain investments of between $1 million and $50 million redeemed within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months of purchase.(p)

Class W*

   none    none

Class Y*

   none    none

Class Z*

   none    none

 

     

Maximum Distribution and Service (12b-1) Fees(c)

  

Non 12b-1
Service Fees(d)

Class A*

  

Legacy Columbia funds: distribution fee up to 0.25% and service fee up to 0.25%;

Legacy RiverSource funds: 0.25% distribution and service fees, except Columbia Money Market Fund, which pays 0.10%.

   none

Class B*

   0.75% distribution fee and 0.25% service fee, with certain exceptions.(c)    none

Class C*

   0.75% distribution fee; 0.25% service fee.    none

Class E

   0.10% distribution fee and 0.25% service fee, with certain exceptions.(c)    none

Class F

   0.75% distribution fee; 0.25% service fee.    none

Class I*

   none    none

Class R*

  

Legacy Columbia funds: 0.50% distribution fee;

Legacy RiverSource funds: 0.50% fee, of which service fee can be up to 0.25%.

   none

Class R3*

   0.25% distribution fee    0.25%(m)

Class R4*

   none    0.25%(m)

Class R5*

   none    none

Class T

   none    up to 0.50%.(o)

Class W*

   0.25% distribution and service fees, with certain exceptions.(c)    none

Class Y*

   none    none

Class Z*

   none    none

 

C-7


Table of Contents

 

 

* For money market Funds, new investments must be made in Class A, Class I, Class T, Class W or Class Z shares, subject to eligibility. Class C and Class R shares of the money market Funds are available as a new investment only to investors in the Distributor’s proprietary 401(k) products, provided that such investor is eligible to invest in the Class and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper. The money market Funds offer other classes of shares only to facilitate exchanges with other Funds offering such share classes.
(a)

See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders for more details on the eligible investors and minimum initial and subsequent investment and account balance requirements.

(b)

Actual front-end sales charges and CDSCs vary among the Funds. For more information on applicable sales charges, see Choosing a Share Class – Sales Charges and Commissions, and for information about certain exceptions to these sales charge policies, see Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges.

(c)

These are the maximum applicable distribution and/or shareholder service fees. Because these fees are paid out of Fund assets on an on-going basis, over time these fees will increase the cost of your investment and may cost you more than paying other types of distribution and/or shareholder service fees. For Legacy Columbia funds with Class A shares subject to both a distribution and service fee, the aggregate fees are limited to not more than 0.25%. Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly RiverSource Cash Management Fund) pays up to 0.75% distribution fee and up to 0.10% service fee on Class B shares, and 0.10% distribution and service fees on Class W shares. Columbia Money Market Fund pays a distribution and service fee of up to 0.10% on Class A shares, up to 0.75% distribution fee and up to 0.10% service fee on Class B shares, and 0.10% distribution and servicing fees on Class W shares. The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive all or a portion of distribution and/or service fees for certain classes of certain Funds. For information on these waivers, see Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees. Compensation paid to selling and/or servicing agents may be suspended to the extent of the Distributor’s waiver of the 12b-1 fees on these specific Fund share classes.

(d)

For more information, see Class R3 and Class R4 Shares – Plan Administration Fees and Class T Shares – Shareholder Service Fees.

(e)

The minimum initial investment requirement is $5,000 for RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, Columbia Floating Rate Fund and Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund, and $10,000 for Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund, Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund and Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund. For more details on the minimum initial investment requirement applicable to other Funds, see Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders.

(f)

The following Funds are not subject to a front-end sales charge or a CDSC on Class A shares: Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund, and RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund.

(g)

There is no CDSC on Class A shares of the money market Funds or the Funds identified in footnote (f) above. Legacy Columbia fund Class A shareholders who purchased Class A shares without an initial sales charge because their accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase and who purchased shares on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase and redemptions after one year will not be subject to a CDSC.

(h)

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except through reinvestment of dividend and/or capital gain distributions by existing Class B shareholders, or a permitted exchange, as described in more detail under Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders – Buying Shares – Class B Shares Closed. Unless contrary instructions are received in advance by the Fund, any purchase orders (except those submitted by a selling and/or servicing agent through the National Securities Clearing Corporation (NSCC) that are initial investments in Class B shares or that are orders for additional Class B shares of the Fund received from existing investors in Class B shares, including orders made through an active systematic investment plan, will automatically be invested in Class A shares of the Fund, without regard to the normal minimum initial investment requirement for Class A shares, but subject to the applicable front-end sales charge. Your selling and/or servicing agent may have different polices, including automatically redirecting the purchase order to a money market fund. See Choosing a Share Class – Class A Shares – Front-end Sales Charge for additional information about Class A shares.

(i)

Timing of conversion and CDSC schedule will vary depending on the Fund and the date of your original purchase of Class B shares. For more information on the timing of conversion of Class B shares to Class A shares, see Choosing a Share Class – Class B Shares – Conversion of Class B Shares to Class A Shares. Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund do not convert to Class A shares. For information on the timing of the conversion of Class F shares to Class E shares, see Choosing a Share Class – Class F Shares – Commissions and Conversion to Class E Shares.

(j)

There is no investment limit on Class C shares purchased by employee benefit plans created under section 401(a), 401(k), 457 and 403(b), and qualified deferred compensation plans, that have a plan level or omnibus account maintained with the Fund or the Transfer Agent and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper.

(k)

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class E or Class F shares, except that existing Class E and/or Class F shareholders who opened and funded their account prior to September 22, 2006 may continue to invest in Class E and/or Class F shares, as described in more detail under Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders – Buying Shares – Class E and Class F Shares Closed. Class E and Class F shares are designed for investors who wish to make an irrevocable gift to a child, grandchild or other individual.

(l)

If you hold Class F shares of the Fund and your account has a value of less than $250,000, you may purchase additional Class F shares of the Fund in amounts that increase your account value up to a maximum of $250,000. The value of your account, for this purpose, includes the value of all Class F shares in eligible accounts held by you and your “immediate family.” For more information about account value aggregation and eligible accounts, see Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges. If you have reached the $250,000 limit, any additional amounts you invest in Class F shares of the Fund will be invested in Class E shares of the Fund, without regard to the normal minimum investment amount required for Class E shares. Such investments will, however, be subject to the applicable front-end sales charge.

(m)

For more information, see Class R3 and Class R4 Shares – Plan Administration Fees.

(n)

Shareholders who opened and funded a Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 shares account with a Fund as of the close of business on December 31, 2010 (including accounts once funded that subsequently reached a zero balance) may continue to make additional purchases of the share class, and existing Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 accounts may continue to allow new investors or participants to be established in their Fund account. For more information on eligible investors in these share classes and the closing of these share classes, see Buying Shares – Eligible Investors – Class R3 Shares, R4 Shares and Class R5 Shares.

 

C-8


Table of Contents
(o)

For more information, see Class T Shares – Shareholder Service Fees.

(p)

Class T Shareholders who purchased Class T shares without a front-end sales charge because their accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of the purchase and who purchased shares on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase and redemptions after one year will not be subject to a CDSC.

(q)

Class Y shares are available only to the following categories of investors: (i) individual investors and institutional clients (endowments, foundations, defined benefit plans, etc.) that invest at least $1 million in Class Y shares of a single Fund and (ii) group retirement plans (including 401(k) plans, 457 plans, employer-sponsored 403(b) plans, profit sharing and money purchase plans) with plan assets of at least $10 million.

Sales Charges and Commissions

Sales charges, commissions and distribution and service fees (discussed in a separate sub-section below) compensate selling and/or servicing agents, and typically your financial advisor, for selling shares to you and for maintaining and servicing the shares held in your account with them. These charges, commissions and fees are intended to provide incentives for selling and/or servicing agents to provide these services.

Depending on which share class you choose, you will pay these charges either at the outset as a front-end sales charge, at the time you sell your shares as a contingent deferred sales charge (CDSC) and/or over time in the form of increased ongoing fees. Whether the ultimate cost is higher for one class over another depends on the amount you invest, how long you hold your shares and whether you are eligible for reduced or waived sales charges. We encourage you to consult with a financial advisor who can help you with your investment decisions.

Class A Shares — Front-End Sales Charge

You’ll pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class A shares (other than shares of a money market Fund and certain other Funds) unless you qualify for a waiver of the sales charge or you buy the shares through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for more information.

The Distributor receives the sales charge and re-allows (or pays) a portion of the sales charge to the selling and/or servicing agent through which you purchased the shares. The Distributor retains the balance of the sales charge. The Distributor retains the full sales charge you pay when you purchase shares of the Fund directly from the Fund (not through a selling and/or servicing agent). Sales charges vary depending on the amount of your purchase.

FUNDamentalsTM

Front-End Sales Charge Calculation

The following tables present the front-end sales charge as a percentage of both the offering price and the net amount invested.

 

 

The offering price per share is the net asset value per share plus any front-end sales charge that applies.

 

 

The net asset value (or NAV) per share is the price of a share calculated by the Fund every business day.

The dollar amount of the sales charge is the difference between the offering price of the shares you buy (based on the applicable sales charge in the table) and the net asset value of those shares.

To determine the front-end sales charge you will pay when you buy your shares, the Fund will add the amount of your investment to the value of your account (and any other accounts eligible for aggregation of which you or your financial advisor notify the Fund) and base the sales charge on the aggregate amount. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/ Waivers of Sales Charges for a discussion of account value aggregation. There is no initial sales charge on reinvested dividend or capital gain distributions.

The front-end sales charge you’ll pay on Class A shares:

 

 

depends on the amount you’re investing (generally, the larger the investment, the smaller the percentage sales charge), and

 

 

is based on the total amount of your purchase and the value of your account (and any other accounts eligible for aggregation of which you or your financial advisor notify the Fund).

 

C-9


Table of Contents

 

Class A Shares — Front-End Sales Charge — Breakpoint Schedule

 

Breakpoint Schedule For:    Dollar amount of
shares bought(a)
     Sales
charge as a
% of
the
offering
price(b)
  Sales
charge as
a % of
the net
amount
invested(b)
  Amount
retained by
or paid to
selling
and/or
servicing
agents as a
% of the
offering
price

Equity Funds and Funds-of Funds (equity)*

     $0 – $49,999       5.75%   6.10%   5.00%
     $50,000 –$99,999       4.50%   4.71%   3.75%
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
   3.50%   3.63%   3.00%
    
 
$250,000 –
$499,999
  
  
   2.50%   2.56%   2.15%
    
 
$500,000 –
$999,999
  
  
   2.00%   2.04%   1.75%
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)

Fixed Income Funds (except those listed below) and Funds-of-Funds (fixed income)*

     $0 – $49,999       4.75%   4.99%   4.00%
    
 
$50,000 –
$99,999
  
  
   4.25%   4.44%   3.50%
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
   3.50%   3.63%   3.00%
    
 
$250,000 –
$499,999
  
  
   2.50%   2.56%   2.15%
    
 
$500,000 –
$999,999
  
  
   2.00%   2.04%   1.75%
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund,

Columbia Floating Rate Fund,

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund,

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund,

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund and

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

     $0 – $99,999       3.00%   3.09%   2.50%
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
   2.50%   2.56%   2.15%
    
 
$250,000 –
$499,999
  
  
   2.00%   2.04%   1.75%
    
 
$500,000 –
$999,999
  
  
   1.50%   1.52%   1.25%
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)

 

C-10


Table of Contents

 

Class A Shares — Front-End Sales Charge — Breakpoint Schedule

 

Breakpoint Schedule For:

   Dollar amount of
shares bought(a)
     Sales
charge as a
% of
the
offering
price(b)
  Sales
charge as
a % of
the net
amount
invested(b)
  Amount
retained by
or paid to
selling
and/or
servicing
agents as a
% of the
offering
price

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund,

Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio,

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund,

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund and

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     $0 – $99,999       3.25%   3.36%   2.75%
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
   2.50%   2.56%   2.15%
    
 
$250,000 –
$499,999
  
  
   2.00%   2.04%   1.75%
    
 
$500,000 –
$999,999
  
  
   1.50%   1.53%   1.25%
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)

Columbia Short-Term Bond Fund and

Columbia Short-Term Municipal Bond Fund

     $0 – $99,999       1.00%   1.01%   0.75%
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
   0.75%   0.76%   0.50%
    
 
$250,000 –
$999,999
  
  
   0.50%   0.50%   0.40%
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)

 

 

*

The following Funds are not subject to a front-end sales charge or a CDSC on Class A shares: Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund and RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund. “Funds-of-Funds (equity)” includes – Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund, Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund, Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund, Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund, Seligman TargETFund 2045, Seligman TargETFund 2035, Seligman TargETFund 2025, Seligman TargETFund 2015 and Seligman TargETFund Core. “Funds-of-Funds (fixed income)” includes – Columbia Income Builder Fund, Columbia Income Builder Fund II, Columbia Income Builder Fund III, Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund and Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund. Columbia Asset Allocation Fund, Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II, Columbia Balanced Fund and Columbia Liberty Fund are treated as equity Funds for purposes of the table.

(a)

Purchase amounts and account values may be aggregated among all eligible Fund accounts for the purposes of this table. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/ Waivers of Sales Charges for a discussion of account value aggregation.

(b)

Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of Fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process. Purchase price includes the sales charge.

 

C-11


Table of Contents

 

(c)

Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the Distributor may pay selling and/or servicing agents the following amounts out of its own resources (except for the Funds listed below): 1.00% on purchases from $1 million up to but not including $3 million; 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and 0.25% on amounts of $50 million or more. The Distributor may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are redeemed. Currently, the Distributor does not make such payments on purchases of the following Funds for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more: Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund, Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund and RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund.

(d)

For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the Distributor the following sales commissions on purchases that are coded as commission-eligible trades: 1.00% on all purchases up to but not including $3 million, including those in amounts of less than $1 million; up to 0.50% on all purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and up to 0.25% on all purchases of $50 million or more.

Class A Shares — CDSC

In some cases, you’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class A shares that you bought without an initial sales charge.

 

 

If you bought Class A shares without an initial sales charge because your accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase, you will incur a CDSC if you redeem those shares in accordance with the following policies:

 

   

Columbia fund shareholders who purchased shares of a legacy Columbia fund on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase.

 

   

Fund shareholders who purchased shares after September 3, 2010 will incur a CDSC if those shares are redeemed within 18 months of purchase, which is charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if shares are redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if shares are redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase.

 

 

Subsequent Class A share purchases that bring your aggregate account value to $1 million or more (but less than $50 million) will also be subject to a CDSC if you redeem them within the time periods noted above.

The CDSC on Class A shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower, and

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions.

In certain circumstances, the CDSC may not apply. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for details.

FUNDamentalsTM

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge

A contingent deferred sales charge or CDSC is a sales charge applied at the time you sell your shares, unlike a front-end sales charge that is applied at the time of purchase. A CDSC varies based on the Fund and the length of time that you have held your shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC on shares of a Legacy Columbia fund and, for shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund purchased after the close of business on September 3, 2010, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made. For purposes of calculating the CDSC on shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund purchased on or before the close of business on September 3, 2010, the start of the holding period is the date your purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of investing in the Fund.

Class A Shares — Commissions

The Distributor may pay your selling and/or servicing agent an up-front commission when you buy Class A shares. The Distributor generally funds the commission through the applicable sales charge paid by you. The up-front commission on Class A shares, which varies by Fund, may be up to 5.00% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 5.75%, up to 4.00% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 4.75%, up to 2.75% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 3.25%, up to 2.50% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 3.00%, and up to 0.75% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 1.00%.

The Distributor may also pay your selling and/or servicing agent a cumulative commission when you buy $1 million or more of Class A shares, according to the following schedule:

Class A Shares — Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Service Agents)*

 

Purchase Amount    Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per share)

$1 million – $2,999,999

       1.00%**

$3 million – $49,999,999

   0.50%

$50 million or more

   0.25%

 

* Not applicable to Funds that do not assess a front-end sales charge.
** For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the Distributor sales commissions on purchases (that are coded as commission-eligible trades) in amounts of less than $1 million.

 

C-12


Table of Contents

 

Class B Shares — Sales Charges

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions involving existing investors in Class B shares as described in more detail below under Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Buying Shares – Eligible Investors – Class B Shares Closed.

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class B shares, but you may pay a CDSC when you sell Class B shares.

Class B Shares — CDSC

The CDSC on Class B shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower,

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares, and

 

 

generally declines each year until there is no sales charge for redeeming shares.

You’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class B shares unless you qualify for a waiver of the CDSC or the shares you’re selling were bought through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for details. Also, you will not pay a CDSC on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares. The CDSC you pay on Class B shares depends on how long you’ve held your shares:

Class B Shares — CDSC Schedule for the Funds

 

     Applicable CDSC*
Number of

Years Class B

Shares Held

   All Funds except those
listed to the right
  Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Short Term Bond Fund, Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Total Return Bond Fund and Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund
One    5.00%   3.00%
Two    4.00%   3.00%
Three    3.00%**   2.00%
Four    3.00%   1.00%
Five    2.00%   None
Six    1.00%   None
Seven    None   None
Eight    None   None
Nine    Conversion to Class A
Shares
  Conversion to Class A Shares

 

* Because of rounding in the calculation, the actual CDSC you pay may be more or less than the CDSC calculated using these percentages.
** For shares purchased in a Legacy RiverSource fund (other than a Seligman fund) on or prior to June 12, 2009, the CDSC percentage for year three is 4%.

 

C-13


Table of Contents

 

Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund are not subject to a CDSC.

Class B Shares — Commissions

If you are an investor who purchased Class B shares prior to their closing (except for certain limited transactions), although there was no front-end sales charge for Class B shares when you bought Class B shares, the Distributor paid an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent when you bought the Class B shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, have been paid to your financial advisor). This up-front commission, which varies across the Funds, was up to 4.00% of the net asset value per share of Funds with a maximum CDSC of 5.00% and of Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund and up to 2.75% of the net asset value per share of Funds with a maximum CDSC of 3.00%. The Distributor continues to seek to recover this commission through distribution fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution plan and any applicable CDSC paid when you sell your shares. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

Class B Shares — Conversion to Class A Shares

Class B shares purchased in a Legacy Columbia fund at any time, a Legacy RiverSource fund (other than a Seligman fund) at any time, or a Seligman fund on or after June 13, 2009 automatically convert to Class A shares after you’ve owned the shares for eight years, except for Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund, which do not convert to Class A shares. Class B shares originally purchased in a Seligman fund on or prior to June 12, 2009 will convert to Class A shares in the month prior to the ninth year of ownership. The conversion feature allows you to benefit from the lower operating costs of Class A shares, which can help increase your total returns from an investment in the Fund.

Class B shares purchased in a Legacy RiverSource fund (other than a Seligman fund) prior to May 21, 2005 age on a calendar year basis. Class B shares purchased in a Legacy Columbia fund at any time, Seligman fund at any time, or a Legacy RiverSource fund on or after May 21, 2005 age on a daily basis. For example, a purchase made on November 12, 2004 completed its first year on December 31, 2004 under calendar year aging, but completed its first year on November 11, 2005 under daily aging.

The following rules apply to the conversion of Class B shares to Class A shares:

 

 

Class B shares are converted on or about the 15th day of the month that they become eligible for conversion. For purposes of determining the month when your Class B shares are eligible for conversion, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made.

 

 

Any shares you received from reinvested distributions on these shares generally will convert to Class A shares at the same time.

 

 

You’ll receive the same dollar value of Class A shares as the Class B shares that were converted. Class B shares that you received from an exchange of Class B shares of another Fund will convert based on the day you bought the original shares.

 

 

No sales charge or other charges apply, and conversions are free from U.S. federal income tax.

Class C Shares — Sales Charges

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class C shares, but you may pay a CDSC when you sell Class C shares.

Class C Shares — CDSC

You’ll pay a CDSC of 1.00% if you redeem Class C shares within one year of buying them unless you qualify for a waiver of the CDSC or the shares you’re selling were bought through reinvested distributions. For details, see Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges. The CDSC on Class C shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower,

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares, and

 

 

is reduced to 0.00% on shares redeemed a year or more after purchase.

Class C Shares — Commissions

Although there is no front-end sales charge when you buy Class C shares, the Distributor pays an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent of up to 1.00% of the net asset value per share when you buy Class C shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor). The Distributor seeks to recover this commission through distribution fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution and/or service plan and any applicable CDSC applied when you sell your shares. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

Class E Shares — Front-End Sales Charge

You’ll pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class E shares unless you qualify for a waiver of the sales charge or you buy the shares through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for more information.

 

C-14


Table of Contents

 

The front-end sales charge you’ll pay on Class E shares:

 

 

depends on the amount you’re investing (generally, the larger the investment, the smaller the percentage sales charge), and

 

 

is based on the total amount of your purchase and the value of your account.

Class E Shares — Front-End Sales Charge — Breakpoint Schedule

 

Dollar amount of
shares bought(a)
   Sales charge as a % of the
offering price(b)
  Sales charge as a % of the
net amount invested(b)
  Amount retained by or paid to selling
and/or servicing agents as a % of the
offering price

$0 – $49,999

   4.50%   4.71%   4.00%

$50,000 – $99,999

   3.50%   3.63%   3.00%

$100,000 – $249,999

   2.50%   2.56%   2.00%

$250,000 – $499,999

   1.25%   1.27%   1.00%

$500,000 – $999,999

   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%

$1,000,000 or more

   0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)

 

(a)

Purchase amounts and account values are aggregated among all eligible Fund accounts for the purposes of this table.

(b)

Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of Fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process.

(c)

Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the Distributor may pay selling and/or servicing agents the following out of its own resources: 1.00% on purchases up to but not including $3 million, 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $5 million and 0.25% on purchases of $5 million or more. The Distributor pays selling and/or servicing agents on investments of $1 million or more, but may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are sold.

Class E Shares — CDSC

In some cases, you’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class E shares that you bought without an initial sales charge.

 

 

If you bought Class E shares without an initial sales charge because your accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase, you will incur a 1.00% CDSC if you redeem those shares within one year of buying them.

 

 

Subsequent Class E share purchases that bring your aggregate account value to $1 million or more (but less than $50 million) will also be subject to a CDSC if you redeem them within one year of buying them.

The CDSC on Class E shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower, and

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which the purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class E shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of your investment in the Funds.

The Distributor may pay your selling and/or servicing agent an up-front commission of up to 4.00% of the offering price per share when you buy Class E shares. The Distributor funds the commission through the applicable sales charge paid by you.

Class E Shares — Commissions

The Distributor may also pay your selling and/or servicing agent a cumulative commission when you buy Class E shares, according to the following schedule:

Class E Shares — Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Servicing Agents)

 

Purchase Amount

   Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per  share)

$0 – $2,999,999

   1.00%

$3 million – $4,999,999

   0.50%

$5 million or more

   0.25%

 

C-15


Table of Contents

 

Class F Shares — Sales Charges

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class F shares, but you may pay a CDSC when you sell Class F shares. The CDSC on Class F shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower,

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares, and

 

 

generally declines each year until there is no sales charge for redeeming shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class F shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of your investment in the Funds.

Class F Shares — CDSC

The CDSC you pay on Class F shares depends on how long you’ve held your shares:

Class F Shares — CDSC Schedule

 

Number of Years Class F Shares Held    Applicable CDSC*

One

   5.00%

Two

   4.00%

Three

   3.00%

Four

   3.00%

Five

   2.00%

Six

   1.00%

Seven

   None

Eight

   None

Nine

   Conversion to Class E Shares

 

* Because of rounding in the calculation, the actual CDSC you pay may be more or less than the CDSC calculated using these percentages.

Class F Shares — Commissions and Conversion to Class E Shares

Although there is no front-end sales charge when you buy Class F shares, the Distributor pays an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent of up to 4.00% of the net asset value per share when you buy Class F shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor). The Distributor seeks to recover this commission through distribution fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution plan and any applicable CDSC when you sell your shares. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

Class F shares automatically convert to Class E shares after you’ve owned them for eight years. This conversion feature allows you to benefit from the lower operating costs of Class E shares, which can help increase your total returns from an investment in the Fund.

The following rules apply to the conversion of Class F shares to Class E shares:

 

 

Class F shares are converted on or about the 15th day of the month that they become eligible for conversion.

 

 

Any shares you received from reinvested distributions on these shares generally will convert to Class E shares at the same time.

 

 

You’ll receive the same dollar value of Class E shares as the Class F shares that were converted. Class F shares that you received from an exchange of Class F shares of another Fund will convert based on the day you bought the original shares.

 

 

No sales charge or other charges apply, and conversions are free from U.S. federal income tax.

Class R Shares – Sales Charges and Commissions

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class R shares of the Fund or a CDSC when you sell Class R shares of the Fund. See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders for more information about investing in Class R shares of the Fund. The Distributor pays an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent when you buy Class R shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor), according to the following schedule:

Class R Shares — Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Servicing Agents)

 

C-16


Table of Contents

 

Purchase Amount    Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per share)  

$0 – $49,999,999

     0.50

$50 million or more

     0.25

The Distributor seeks to recover this commission through distribution and/or service fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution and/or service plan. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

Class T Shares — Front-End Sales Charge

You’ll pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class T shares unless you qualify for a waiver of the sales charge or you buy the shares through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for more information.

The front-end sales charge you’ll pay on Class T shares:

 

depends on the amount you’re investing (generally, the larger the investment, the smaller the percentage sales charge), and

 

 

is based on the total amount of your purchase and the value of your account.

Class T Shares — Front-End Sales Charge — Breakpoint Schedule

 

Breakpoint Schedule For:

   Dollar amount of
shares bought(a)
     Sales charge as a %
of the offering
price(b)
    Sales charge as a %
of the net amount
invested(b)
    Amount retained by
or paid to selling
and/or servicing
agents as a % of the
offering price
 
     $0 – $49,999         5.75     6.10     5.00
     $50,000 – $99,999         4.50     4.71     3.75
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
     3.50     3.63     2.75

Equity Funds

    
 
$250,000 –
$499,999
  
  
     2.50     2.56     2.00
    
 
$500,000 –
$999,999
  
  
     2.00     2.04     1.75
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
     0.00     0.00     0.00 %(c)(d) 
     $0 – $49,999         4.75     4.99     4.25
     $50,000 – $99,999         4.50     4.71     3.75
    
 
$100,000 –
$249,999
  
  
     3.50     3.63     2.75

Fixed Income Funds

    
 
$250,000 –
$499,999
  
  
     2.50     2.56     2.00
    
 
$500,000 –
$999,999
  
  
     2.00     2.04     1.75
    
 
$1,000,000 or
more
  
  
     0.00     0.00     0.00 %(c)(d) 

 

(a)

Purchase amounts and account values are aggregated among all eligible Fund accounts for the purposes of this table.

(b)

Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of Fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process.

(c)

Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the Distributor may pay selling and/or servicing agents the following amounts out of its own resources: 1.00% on purchases of $1 million up to but not including $3 million, 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million and 0.25% on purchases of $50 million or more. The Distributor pays selling and/or servicing agents on investments of $1 million or more, but may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are sold.

 

C-17


Table of Contents
(d)

For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the Distributor the following sales commissions on purchases that are coded as commission-eligible trades: 1.00% on purchases up to but not including $3 million (including those in amounts of less than $1 million), up to 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million, and up to 0.25% on purchases of $50 million or more.

Class T Shares — CDSC

In some cases, you’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class T shares that you bought without an initial sales charge.

 

 

If you bought Class T shares without a front-end sales charge because your accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase, you will incur a CDSC if you redeem those shares in accordance with the following policies:

 

   

Shareholders who purchased shares of a Legacy Columbia fund on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase.

 

   

Shareholders who purchased shares of a Fund after September 3, 2010 will incur a CDSC if those shares are redeemed within 18 months of purchase, which is charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if shares are redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if shares are redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months of purchase.

 

 

Subsequent Class T share purchases that bring your aggregate account value to $1 million or more (but less than $50 million) will also be subject to a CDSC if you redeem them within one year of purchase.

The CDSC on Class T shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower, and

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which the purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class T shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of your investment in the Funds.

In certain circumstances, the CDSC may not apply. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for details.

Class T Shares — Commissions

The Distributor may pay your selling and/or servicing agent an up-front commission when you buy Class T shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor). The up-front commission, which varies by Fund, may be up to 5.00% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 5.75% and up to 4.25% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 4.75%.

The Distributor may also pay your selling and/or servicing agent a cumulative commission when you buy $1 million or more of Class T shares, according to the following schedule:

Class T Shares — Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Servicing Agents)

Purchase Amount    Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per share)  

$1 million – $2,999,999

     1.00

$3 million – $49,999,999

     0.50

$50 million or more

     0.25

Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges

Front-End Sales Charge Reductions

There are two ways in which you may be able to reduce the front-end sales charge that you may pay when you buy Class A, Class E or Class T shares of a Fund. These types of sales charge reductions are also referred to as breakpoint discounts.

First, through the right of accumulation (ROA), you may combine the value of eligible accounts maintained by you and members of your immediate family to reach a breakpoint discount level and apply a lower sales charge to your purchase. To calculate the combined value of your accounts in the particular class of shares, the Fund will use the current public offering price per share. For purposes of obtaining a Class A shares breakpoint discount through ROA, you may aggregate your or your immediate family members’ ownership of different classes of shares, except for Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of the Funds, which may not be aggregated.

 

C-18


Table of Contents

 

Second, by making a statement of intent to purchase additional shares (commonly referred to as a letter of intent (LOI)), you may pay a lower sales charge on all purchases (including existing ROA purchases) of Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares made within 13 months of the date of your LOI. Your LOI must state the aggregate amount of purchases you intend to make in that 13-month period, which must be at least $50,000. The required form of LOI may vary by selling and/or servicing agent, so please contact them directly for more information. Five percent of the purchase commitment amount will be placed in escrow. At the end of the 13-month period, the shares will be released from escrow, provided that you have invested the commitment amount. If you do not invest the purchase commitment amount by the end of the 13 months, the remaining amount of the unpaid sales charge will be redeemed from the escrowed shares and the remaining balance released from escrow. To calculate the total value of the purchases you’ve made under an LOI, the Fund will use the historic cost (i.e., dollars invested) of the shares held in each eligible account. For purposes of making an LOI to purchase additional shares, you may aggregate your ownership of different classes of shares, except for Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of the Funds, which may not be aggregated.

You must request the reduced sales charge (whether through ROA or an LOI) when you buy shares. If you do not complete and file an LOI, or do not request the reduced sales charge at the time of purchase, you will not be eligible for the reduced sales charge. To obtain a breakpoint discount, you must notify your selling and/or servicing agent in writing at the time you buy your shares of each eligible account maintained by you and members of your immediate family, including accounts maintained through different selling and/or servicing agents. You and your selling and/or servicing agent are responsible for ensuring that you receive discounts for which you are eligible. The Fund is not responsible for a selling and/or servicing agent’s failure to apply the eligible discount to your account. You may be asked by your selling and/or servicing agent for account statements or other records to verify your discount eligibility, including, when applicable, records for accounts opened with a different selling and/or servicing agent and records of accounts established by members of your immediate family.

FUNDamentalsTM

Your “Immediate Family” and Account Value Aggregation

For purposes of reaching the Class F shares investment limits described in Choosing a Share Class – Comparison of the Share Classes or obtaining a Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares breakpoint discount, the value of your account will be deemed to include the value of all applicable shares in eligible accounts that are held by you and your “immediate family,” which includes your spouse, domestic partner, parent, step-parent, legal guardian, child, step-child, father-in-law and mother-in-law, provided that you and your immediate family members share the same mailing address. Any Fund accounts linked together for account value aggregation purposes as of the close of business on September 3, 2010 will be permitted to remain linked together. Remember that in order to obtain a breakpoint discount, you must notify your selling and/or servicing agent in writing at the time you buy your shares of each eligible account maintained by you and members of your immediate family. Group plan accounts are valued at the plan level.

Eligible Accounts

The following accounts are eligible for account value aggregation as described above:

 

 

Individual or joint accounts;

 

 

Roth and traditional Individual Retirement Accounts (IRAs), Simplified Employee Pension accounts (SEPs), Savings Investment Match Plans for Employees of Small Employers accounts (SIMPLEs) and Tax Sheltered Custodial Accounts (TSCAs);

 

 

Uniform Gifts to Minors Act (UGMA)/Uniform Transfers to Minors (UTMA) accounts for which you, your spouse, or your domestic partner is parent or guardian of the minor child;

 

 

Revocable trust accounts for which you or an immediate family member, individually, is the beneficial owner/grantor;

 

 

Accounts held in the name of your, your spouse’s, or your domestic partner’s sole proprietorship or single owner limited liability company or S corporation;

 

 

Qualified retirement plan assets, provided that you are the sole owner of the business sponsoring the plan, are the sole participant (other than a spouse) in the plan, and have no intention of adding participants to the plan; and

 

 

Investments in wrap accounts;

provided that each of the accounts identified above is invested in Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class W and/or Class Z shares of the Funds.

The following accounts are not eligible for account value aggregation as described above:

 

 

Accounts of pension and retirement plans with multiple participants, such as 401(k) plans (which are combined to reduce the sales charge for the entire pension or retirement plan and therefore are not used to reduce the sales charge for your individual accounts);

 

 

Accounts invested in Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of the Funds;

 

 

Investments in 529 plans, donor advised funds, variable annuities, variable life insurance products, or managed separate accounts;

 

 

Charitable and irrevocable trust accounts; and

 

 

Accounts holding shares of money market Funds that used the Columbia brand before May 1, 2010.

 

C-19


Table of Contents

 

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

The following categories of investors may buy Class A, Class E and Class T shares of the Funds at net asset value, without payment of any front-end sales charge that would otherwise apply:

 

 

Current or retired Fund Board members, officers or employees of the Funds or Columbia Management or its affiliates(1);

 

 

Current or retired Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc. financial advisors and employees of such financial advisors(1);

 

 

Registered representatives and other employees of affiliated or unaffiliated selling and/or servicing agent having a selling agreement with the Distributor(1);

 

 

Registered broker/dealer firms that have entered into a dealer agreement with the Distributor may buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge for their investment account only;

 

 

Portfolio managers employed by subadvisers of the Funds(1);

 

 

Partners and employees of outside legal counsel to the Funds or the Funds’ directors or trustees who regularly provide advice and services to the Funds, or to their directors or trustees;

 

 

Direct rollovers from qualified employee benefit plans, provided that the rollover involves a transfer to Class A shares in the same Fund;

 

 

Purchases made:

 

   

With dividend or capital gain distributions from a Fund or from the same class of another Fund;

 

   

Through or under a wrap fee product or other investment product sponsored by a selling and/or servicing agent that charges an account management fee or other managed agency/asset allocation accounts or programs involving fee-based compensation arrangements that have or that clear trades through a selling and/or servicing agent that has a selling agreement with the Distributor;

 

   

Through state sponsored college savings plans established under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code; or

 

   

Through banks, trust companies and thrift institutions, acting as fiduciaries;

 

 

Separate accounts established and maintained by an insurance company which are exempt from registration under Section 3(c)(11);

 

 

Purchases made through “employee benefit plans” created under section 401(a), 401(k), 457 and 403(b), and qualified deferred compensation plans that have a plan level or omnibus account maintained with the Fund or the Transfer Agent and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper; and

 

 

At the Fund’s discretion, front-end sales charges may be waived for shares issued in plans of reorganization, such as mergers, asset acquisitions and exchange offers, to which the Fund is a party.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Funds may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your selling and/or servicing agent with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your selling and/or servicing agent provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. Please see the Merger SAI for more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers.

 

(1)

Including their spouses or domestic partners, children or step-children, parents, step-parents or legal guardians, and their spouse’s or domestic partner’s parents, step-parents, or legal guardians.

CDSC Waivers

You may be able to avoid an otherwise applicable CDSC when you sell Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F or Class T shares of the Fund. This could happen because of the way in which you originally invested in the Fund, because of your relationship with the Funds or for other reasons.

CDSC — Waivers of the CDSC for Class A, Class C, Class E, Class F and Class T shares. The CDSC will be waived on redemptions of shares:

 

 

in the event of the shareholder’s death;

 

 

for which no sales commission or transaction fee was paid to an authorized selling and/or servicing agent at the time of purchase;

 

 

purchased through reinvestment of dividend and capital gain distributions;

 

 

in an account that has been closed because it falls below the minimum account balance;

 

 

that result from required minimum distributions taken from retirement accounts upon the shareholder’s attainment of age 70 1/2;

 

 

that result from returns of excess contributions made to retirement plans or individual retirement accounts, so long as the selling and/or servicing agent returns the applicable portion of any commission paid by the Distributor;

 

C-20


Table of Contents

 

 

of Class A shares of a Fund initially purchased by an employee benefit plan;

 

 

other than Class A shares, of a Fund initially purchased by an employee benefit plan that are not connected with a plan level termination;

 

 

in connection with the Fund’s Small Account Policy (which is described below in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies);

 

 

at a Fund's discretion, issued in connection with plans of reorganization, including but not limited to mergers, asset acquisitions and exchange offers, to which the Fund is a party; and

 

 

by certain other investors as set forth in more detail in the Merger SAI.

CDSC — Waivers of the CDSC for Class B shares. The CDSC will be waived on redemptions of shares:

 

 

in the event of the shareholder’s death;

 

 

that result from required minimum distributions taken from retirement accounts upon the shareholder’s attainment of age 70 1/2;

 

 

in connection with the Fund’s Small Account Policy (which is described below in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies); and

 

 

by certain other investors, including certain institutions as set forth in more detail in the Merger SAI.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases.

Please see the Merger SAI for more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here.

Repurchases

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a redemption of any Class A, B, C or T shares of the Fund (other than Columbia Money Market Fund or Columbia Government Money Market Fund) within 90 days, up to the amount of the redemption proceeds. Any CDSC paid upon redemption of your Class A, B, C or T shares of the Fund will not be reimbursed. If your original purchase was in Class T shares, you will be allowed to reinvest in the same Class T shares account and Fund you originally purchased.

To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges, the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request from you or your selling and/or servicing agent within 90 days after the shares are redeemed and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order. The repurchased shares will be deemed to have the original purchase date for purposes of applying the CDSC (if any) to subsequent redemptions. Systematic withdrawals and purchases are excluded from this policy.

Distribution and Service Fees

Pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, the applicable Board has approved, and the Funds have adopted, distribution and/or shareholder service plans which set the distribution and/or service fees that are periodically deducted from the Fund assets. These fees are calculated daily, may vary by share class and are intended to compensate the Distributor and/or eligible selling and/or servicing agents for selling shares of the Fund and providing services to investors. Because the fees are paid out of the Fund’s assets on an ongoing basis, they will increase the cost of your investment over time.

 

C-21


Table of Contents

 

The table below shows the maximum annual distribution and/or service fees (as an annual % of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees applicable to each share class:

 

        Distribution Fee   Service Fee   Combined Total

Class A

     up to 0.25%   up to 0.25%   up to  0.35%(a)(b)(c)

Class B

     0.75%   0.25%   1.00%(a)(b)

Class C

     0.75%   0.25%   1.00%(d)

Class E

     0.10%   0.25%   0.35%

Class F

     0.75%   0.25%   1.00%

Class I

     none   none   None

Class R (Legacy Columbia funds)

     0.50%   (e)   0.50%

Class R (Legacy RiverSource funds)

     up to 0.50%   up to 0.25%   0.50%(e)

Class R3

     0.25%   0.25%(f)   0.50%(f)

Class R4

     none   0.25%(f)   0.25%(f)

Class R5

     none   None   none

Class T

     none   0.50%(g)   0.50%(g)

Class W

     up to 0.25%   up to 0.25%   0.25%(c)

Class Y

     none   none   none

Class Z

     none   none   none

 

(a)

As shown in the table below, the maximum distribution and service fees of Class A shares varies among the Funds, as follows:

 

Funds

   Maximum
Class A
Distribution Fee
  Maximum
Class A
Service Fee
 

Maximum
Class A
Combined Total

Legacy RiverSource funds (other than Columbia Money Market Fund)

   Up to 0.25%   Up to 0.25%   0.25%

Columbia Money Market Fund

       0.10%
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund, Columbia Balanced Fund, Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund, Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, Columbia Dividend Income Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund, Columbia Small Cap Core Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I, Columbia Technology Fund    up to 0.10%   up to 0.25%   up to 0.35%; these Funds may pay distribution and service fees up to a maximum of 0.35% of the their average daily net assets attributable to Class A shares (comprised of up to 0.10% for distribution services and up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services) but currently limit such fees to an aggregate fee of not more than 0.25% for Class A shares.
Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Bond Fund, Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Core Bond Fund, Columbia Corporate Income Fund, Columbia Emerging Markets Fund, Columbia Federal Securities Fund, Columbia Greater China Fund, Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund, Columbia Liberty Fund, Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Columbia International Bond Fund, Columbia    —     0.25%   0.25%

 

C-22


Table of Contents

 

International Growth Fund, Columbia International Stock Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund, Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Select Small Cap Fund, Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Strategic Income Fund, Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund, Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund, Columbia World Equity Fund        
Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund, Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Tax Exempt Fund       0.20%   0.20%
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II, Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Convertible Securities Fund, Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Global Value Fund, Columbia High Income Fund, Columbia International Value Fund, Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Columbia Marsico Global Fund, Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Short Term Bond Fund, Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Total Return Bond Fund, Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Large Cap Value Fund, Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund, Columbia Marsico Growth Fund, Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio, Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II, Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund, Columbia Overseas Value Fund    —      —     0.25%; these Funds pay a combined distribution and service fee pursuant to their combined distribution and shareholder servicing plan for Class A shares.

 

(b)

The service fees for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of certain Funds depend on when the shares were purchased, as described below. Service Fee for Class A shares and Class B shares of Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund and Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.10% on net assets attributable to shares of these Funds issued prior to December 1, 1994 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to Fund shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.10% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2009, the blended service fee was 0.24% of the Fund’s average net assets for each of these Funds, other than Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund, which had a blended service fee of 0.23%. Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Columbia Liberty Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.15% on net assets attributable to shares of this Fund issued prior to April 1, 1989 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for all shares that is a blend between the 0.15% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2009, the blended service fee was 0.24% of the Fund’s average daily net assets.

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Columbia Strategic Income Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.15% on net assets attributable to shares of this Fund issued prior to January 1, 1993 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for all Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.15% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended May 31, 2010, the blended service fee was 0.25% of the Fund’s average net assets.

 

C-23


Table of Contents
 

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund, Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.20% of the average daily net asset value of all shares of such Fund class. Distribution Fee for Class B shares and Class C shares for Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund – The annual distribution fee shall be 0.65% of the average daily net assets of the Fund’s Class B shares and Class C shares. Fee amounts noted apply to Class B shares of the Funds other than Class B shares of Columbia Money Market Fund, which pay distribution fees of up to 0.75% and service fees of up to 0.10%, for a combined total of 0.85%.

(c)

Fee amounts noted apply to all Funds other than Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly RiverSource Cash Management Fund), which, for each of Class A and Class W shares, pays distribution and service fees of 0.10%, and for Class C shares pays distribution fees of 0.75%. The Distributor has voluntarily agreed, effective April 15, 2010, to waive the 12b-1 fees it receives from Class A, Class C, Class R (formerly Class R2) and Class W shares of Columbia Money Market Fund and from Class A, Class C and Class R (formerly Class R2) shares of Columbia Government Money Market Fund. Compensation paid to broker-dealers and other financial intermediaries may be suspended to the extent of the Distributor’s waiver of the 12b-1 fees on these specific share classes of these Funds.

(d)

The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares of the following Funds so that the combined distribution and service fee (or the distribution fee for Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund and Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund) does not exceed the specified percentage annually: 0.40% for Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund; 0.45% for Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund and Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund; 0.56% for Columbia Short Term Bond Fund; 0.65% for Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund; 0.80% for Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund and Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund; 0.85% for Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund, Columbia Core Bond Fund, Columbia Corporate Income Fund, Columbia Federal Securities Fund, Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund, Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Strategic Income Fund and Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund. These arrangements may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

(e)

Class R shares of Legacy Columbia funds pay a distribution fee pursuant to a distribution (Rule 12b-1) plan for Class R shares. The Legacy Columbia funds do not have a shareholder service plan for Class R shares. The Legacy RiverSource funds have a distribution and shareholder service plan for Class R shares, which, prior to the close of business on September 3, 2010, were known as Class R2 shares. For Legacy RiverSource fund Class R shares, the maximum fee under the plan reimbursed for distribution expenses is equal on an annual basis to 0.50% of the average daily net assets of the Fund attributable to Class R shares. Of that amount, up to 0.25% may be reimbursed for shareholder service expenses.

(f)

The shareholder service fees for Class R3 and Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a plan administration services agreement, the Funds’ Class R3 and Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

(g)

The shareholder servicing fees for Class T shares are up to 0.50% of average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for equity Funds (including Columbia Asset Allocation Fund) and 0.40% for fixed income Funds. The Funds currently limit such fees to a maximum of 0.30% for equity Funds and 0.15% for fixed-income Funds other than Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, for which the limit currently is 0.00%. See Class T Shareholder Service Fees below for more information.

The distribution and/or shareholder service fees for Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class R and Class W shares, as applicable, are subject to the requirements of Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, and are used by the Distributor to make payments, or to reimburse the Distributor for certain expenses it incurs, in connection with distributing the Fund’s shares and directly or indirectly providing services to Fund shareholders. These payments or expenses include providing distribution and/or shareholder service fees to selling and/or servicing agents that sell shares of the Fund or provide services to Fund shareholders. The Distributor may retain these fees otherwise payable to selling and/or servicing agents if the amounts due are below an amount determined by the Distributor in its discretion.

For Legacy RiverSource fund Class A, Class B and Class W shares, the Distributor begins to pay these fees immediately after purchase. For Legacy RiverSource fund Class C shares, the Distributor pays these fees in advance for the first 12 months. Selling and/or servicing agents also receive distribution fees up to 0.75% of the average daily net assets of Legacy RiverSource fund Class C shares sold and held through them, which the Distributor begins to pay 12 months after purchase. For Legacy RiverSource fund Class B shares, and, for the first 12 months following the sale of Legacy RiverSource fund Class C shares, the Distributor retains the distribution fee of up to 0.75% in order to finance the payment of sales commissions to selling and/or servicing agents, and to pay for other distribution related expenses. Selling and/or servicing agents may compensate their financial advisors with the shareholder service and distribution fees paid to them by the Distributor.

For Legacy Columbia fund Class E, Class R shares and, with the exception noted in the next sentence, Class A shares, the Distributor begins to pay these fees immediately after purchase. For Legacy Columbia fund Class B, Class F, Class A (if purchased as part of a purchase of shares of $1 million or more) and, with the exception noted in the next sentence, Class C shares, the Distributor begins to pay these fees 12 months after purchase (for Columbia fund Class B and Class F shares, and, for the first 12 months following the sale of Columbia Class C shares, the Distributor retains the distribution fee of up to 0.75% in order to finance the payment of sales commissions to selling and/or servicing agents, and to pay for other distribution related expenses). For Legacy Columbia fund Class C shares, selling and/or servicing agents may opt to decline payment of sales commission and, instead, may receive these fees immediately after purchase. Selling and/or servicing agents may compensate their financial advisors with the shareholder service and distribution fees paid to them by the Distributor.

 

C-24


Table of Contents

 

If you maintain shares of the Fund directly with the Fund, without working directly with a financial advisor or selling and/or servicing agent, distribution and service fees may be retained by the Distributor as payment or reimbursement for incurring certain distribution and shareholder service related expenses.

Over time, these distribution and/or shareholder service fees will reduce the return on your investment and may cost you more than paying other types of sales charges. The Fund will pay these fees to the Distributor and/or to eligible selling and/or servicing agents for as long as the distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans continue in effect. The Fund may reduce or discontinue payments at any time. Your selling and/or servicing agent may also charge you other additional fees for providing services to your account, which may be different from those described here.

Class T Shareholder Service Fees

The Funds that offer Class T shares have adopted a shareholder servicing plan that permits them to pay for certain services provided to Class T shareholders by their selling and/or servicing agents. Equity Funds (including Columbia Asset Allocation Fund) may pay shareholder servicing fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.50% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.25% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.30% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services. Fixed income Funds may pay shareholder service fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.40% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of an annual rate of up to 0.20% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.20% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.15% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services, other than Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, for which the limit currently is 0.00%.

Class R3 and Class R4 Shares Plan Administration Fee

Class R3 and Class R4 shares pay an annual plan administration services fee for the provision of various administrative, recordkeeping, communication and educational services. The fee for Class R3 and Class R4 shares is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of average daily net assets attributable to the class.

Selling and/or Servicing Agent Compensation

The Distributor and the investment manager make payments, from their own resources, to selling and/or servicing agents, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for marketing/sales support services relating to the Funds. Such payments are generally based upon one or more of the following factors: average net assets of the Funds sold by the Distributor attributable to that intermediary, gross sales of the Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that intermediary, reimbursement of ticket charges (fees that a selling and/or servicing agent charges its representatives for effecting transactions in Fund shares) or a negotiated lump sum payment. While the financial arrangements may vary for each intermediary, the support payments to any one intermediary are generally between 0.05% and 0.50% on an annual basis for payments based on average net assets of the Fund attributable to the intermediary, and between 0.05% and 0.25% on an annual basis for firms receiving a payment based on gross sales of the Funds attributable to the intermediary.

The Distributor and the investment manager may make payments in larger amounts or on a basis other than those described above when dealing with certain selling and/or servicing agents, including certain affiliates of Bank of America Corporation (Bank of America). Such increased payments may enable such selling and/or servicing agents to offset credits that they may provide to customers.

The Distributor, the Transfer Agent and the investment manager may also make payments to financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, that provide shareholder services to retirement plans and other investment programs to compensate those selling and/or servicing agents for services they provide to such programs, including, but not limited to, sub-accounting, sub-transfer agency, similar shareholder or participant recordkeeping, shareholder or participant reporting, or shareholder or participant transaction processing.

These payments for shareholder servicing support vary by selling and/or servicing agent but generally are not expected, with certain limited exceptions, to exceed 0.40% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares in any intermediary’s program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that pay a service fee pursuant to a plan under Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, and 0.45% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares in any intermediary’s program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that do not pay a service fee pursuant to a plan under Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act.

For all classes other than Class Y shares, the Funds may reimburse the Transfer Agent for amounts paid to selling and/or servicing agents that maintain assets in omnibus accounts, subject to an annual cap that varies among Funds. Generally, the annual cap for each Fund (other than the Columbia Acorn funds) is 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in each such

 

C-25


Table of Contents

account for selling and/or servicing agents that seek payment by the Transfer Agent based on a percentage of net assets. Please see the Merger SAI for additional information. The annual cap for Columbia Acorn funds is 0.05% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in such accounts. The amounts in excess of that reimbursed by the Fund are borne by the Distributor or the investment manager. The Distributor and the investment manager may make other payments or allow promotional incentives to broker/dealers to the extent permitted by SEC and Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA) rules and by other applicable laws and regulations.

Amounts paid by the Distributor and the investment manager and their affiliates are paid out of the Distributor’s and the investment manager’s own resources and do not increase the amount paid by you or the Fund. You can find further details in the Merger SAI about the payments made by the Distributor and the investment manager and their affiliates, as well as a list of the selling and/or servicing agents, including Ameriprise Financial affiliates, to which the Distributor and the investment manager have agreed to make marketing support payments. Your selling and/or servicing agent may charge you fees and commissions in addition to those described herein. You should consult with your selling and/or servicing agent and review carefully any disclosure your selling and/or servicing agent provides regarding its services and compensation. Depending on the financial arrangement in place at any particular time, a selling and/or servicing agent and its financial advisors may have a financial incentive for recommending the Fund or a particular share class over others.

Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares

Share Price Determination

The price you pay or receive when you buy, sell or exchange shares is the Fund’s next determined net asset value (or NAV) per share for a given share class. The Fund calculates the net asset value per share for each class of the Fund at the end of each business day.

FUNDamentalsTM

NAV Calculation

Each of the Fund’s share classes calculates its NAV per share as follows:

                               (Value of assets of the share class)

 

  NAV =        – (Liabilities of the share class)   
      Number of outstanding shares of the class   

FUNDamentalsTM

Business Days

A business day is any day that the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) is open. A business day ends at the close of regular trading on the NYSE, usually at 4:00 p.m. Eastern time. If the NYSE closes early, the business day ends as of the time the NYSE closes. On holidays and other days when the NYSE is closed, the Fund’s net asset value is not calculated and the Fund does not accept buy or sell orders. However, the value of the Fund’s assets may still change on days that the NYSE is closed, including to the extent that the Fund holds foreign securities that trade on days that foreign securities markets are open.

The value of the Fund’s shares is based on the total market value of all of the securities and other assets that it holds as of a specified time. The prices reported on stock exchanges and other securities markets around the world are usually used to value securities in the Fund. The Fund uses the amortized cost method, which approximates market value, to value short-term investments maturing in 60 days or less. For a Fund organized as a fund-of-funds, the assets will consist primarily of shares of the underlying funds, which are valued at their NAVs.

If a market price isn’t readily available, the Fund will determine the price of the security held by the Fund based on the investment manager’s determination of the security’s fair value. A market price is considered not readily available if, among other circumstances, the most recent reported price is deemed unreliable. In addition, the Fund may use fair valuation to price securities that trade on a foreign exchange when a significant event has occurred after the foreign exchange closes but before the time at which the Fund’s share price is calculated. Foreign exchanges typically close before the time at which Fund share prices are calculated, and may be closed altogether on some days when the Fund is open. Such significant events affecting a foreign security may include, but are not limited to: (1) those impacting a single issuer; (2) governmental action that affects securities in one sector or country; (3) natural disasters or armed conflicts affecting a country or region; or (4) significant domestic or foreign market fluctuations. The Fund uses

 

C-26


Table of Contents

various criteria, including an evaluation of U.S. market moves after the close of foreign markets, in determining whether a security’s market price is readily available and, if not, the fair value of the security.

Fair valuation may have the effect of reducing stale pricing arbitrage opportunities presented by the pricing of Fund shares. However, when the Fund uses fair valuation to price securities, it may value those securities higher or lower than another fund would have priced the security. Also, the use of fair valuation may cause the Fund’s performance to diverge to a greater degree from the performance of various benchmarks used to compare the Fund’s performance because benchmarks generally do not use fair valuation techniques. Because of the judgment involved in fair valuation decisions, there can be no assurance that the value ascribed to a particular security is accurate. The Fund has retained one or more independent fair valuation pricing services to assist in the fair valuation process for foreign securities. International markets are sometimes open on days when U.S. markets are closed, which means that the value of foreign securities owned by the Fund could change on days when Fund shares cannot be bought or sold.

For money market Funds, the Fund’s investments are valued at amortized cost, which approximates market value.

Transaction Rules and Policies

Remember that sales charges may apply to your transactions. You should also ask your selling and/or servicing agent about its rules, fees and policies for buying, selling and exchanging shares, which may be different from those described here, and about its related programs or services.

Also remember that the Fund may refuse any order to buy or exchange shares. If this happens, the Fund will return any money it received, but no interest will be paid on that money.

Order Processing

Orders to buy, sell or exchange Fund shares are processed on business days. Depending upon the class of shares, orders can be delivered by mail, by telephone or online. Orders received in “good form” by the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent before the end of a business day are priced at the Fund’s net asset value per share on that day. Orders received after the end of a business day will receive the next business day’s net asset value per share. The market value of the Fund’s investments may change between the time you submit your order and the time the Fund next calculates its net asset value per share. The business day that applies to your order is also called the trade date.

“Good Form”

An order is in “good form” if the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent has all of the information and documentation it deems necessary to effect your order. For example, when you sell shares by letter of instruction, “good form” means that your letter has (i) complete instructions and the signatures of all account owners, (ii) a Medallion Signature Guarantee (as described below) for amounts greater than $100,000 and (iii) any other required documents completed and attached. For the documents required for sales by corporations, agents, fiduciaries, surviving joint owners and other legal entities, call 800.345.6611.

Medallion Signature Guarantees

A Medallion Signature Guarantee helps assure that a signature is genuine and not a forgery. The selling and/or servicing agent providing the Medallion Signature Guarantee is financially liable for the transaction if the signature is a forgery.

Qualified customers can obtain a Medallion Signature Guarantee from any financial institution – including commercial banks, credit unions and broker/dealers – that participates in one of the three Medallion Signature Guarantee programs recognized by the Securities and Exchange Commission. These Medallion Signature Guarantee programs are the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program (STAMP), the Stock Exchanges Medallion Program (SEMP) and the New York Stock Exchange Medallion Signature Program (MSP). Please note that a guarantee from a notary public is not acceptable.

A Medallion Signature Guarantee is required if:

 

 

The amount is greater than $100,000.

 

 

You want your check made payable to someone other than the registered account owner(s).

 

 

Your address of record has changed within the last 30 days.

 

 

You want the check mailed to an address other than the address of record.

 

 

You want the proceeds sent to a bank account not on file.

 

 

You are the beneficiary of the account and the account owner is deceased (additional documents may be required).

 

C-27


Table of Contents

 

Written Transactions

Once you have an account, you can communicate written buy, sell and exchange orders to the Transfer Agent at The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp at the following address (regular mail) P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 and (express mail) 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809.

Telephone Transactions

For Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shareholders, once you have an account, you may place orders to buy, sell or exchange shares by telephone. To place orders by telephone, call 800.422.3737. Have your account number and social security number (SSN) or taxpayer identification number (TIN) available when calling.

You can sell up to and including an aggregate of $100,000 of shares via the telephone per day, per Fund, if you qualify for telephone orders. Wire redemptions requested via the telephone are subject to a maximum of $3 million of shares per day, per Fund. You can buy up to and including $100,000 of shares per day, per Fund through your bank account as an Automated Clearing House (ACH) transaction via the telephone if you qualify for telephone orders.

Telephone orders may not be as secure as written orders. The Funds will take reasonable steps to confirm that telephone instructions are genuine. For example, we require proof of your identification before we will act on instructions received by telephone and may record telephone conversations. However, the Fund and its agents will not be responsible for any losses, costs or expenses resulting from an unauthorized telephone instruction when reasonable steps have been taken to confirm that telephone instructions are genuine. Telephone orders may be difficult to complete during periods of significant economic or market change or business interruption.

Online Transactions

Once Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shareholders have an account, they may contact the Transfer Agent at 800.345.6611 for more information on account trading restrictions and the special sign-up procedures required for online transactions. The Transfer Agent has procedures in place to authenticate electronic orders you deliver through the internet. You will be required to accept the terms of an online agreement and to establish and utilize a password in order to access online account services.

You can sell up to and including an aggregate of $100,000 of shares per day, per Fund account through the internet if you qualify for internet orders.

Customer Identification Program

U.S. Federal law requires the Fund to obtain and record specific personal information to verify your identity when you open an account. This information may include your name, address, date of birth (for individuals) and taxpayer or other government issued identification (e.g., SSN or TIN). If you fail to provide the requested information, the Fund may need to delay the date of your purchase or may be unable to open your account, which may result in a return of your investment monies. In addition, if the Fund is unable to verify your identity after your account is open, the Fund reserves the right to close your account or take other steps as deemed reasonable. The Fund will not be liable for any loss resulting from any purchase delay, application rejection or account closure due to a failure to provide proper identifying information.

Small Account Policy — Class A, B, C, T and Z Share Accounts Below $250

The Funds generally will automatically sell your shares if the value of your Fund account (treating each account of the Fund you own separately from any other account of the Fund you may own) falls below $250. If your shares are sold, the Transfer Agent will remit the sale proceeds to you. Any otherwise applicable CDSC will not be imposed on such an automatic sale of your shares. The Transfer Agent will send you written notification in advance of any automatic sale, which will provide details on how you may avoid such an automatic sale. Generally, you may avoid such an automatic sale by raising your account balance, consolidating your accounts through an exchange of shares of another Fund in which you hold shares, or setting up a Systematic Investment Plan. For more information, contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. The Transfer Agent’s contact information (toll-free number and mailing address) as well as the Funds’ website address can be found at the beginning of the section Choosing a Share Class.

The Fund may also sell your Fund shares if your selling and/or servicing agent tells us to sell your shares pursuant to arrangements made with you, and under certain other circumstances allowed under the 1940 Act.

Small Account Policy — Class A, B, C, T and Z Share Accounts Minimum Balance Fee

If the value of your Fund account (treating each account of the Fund you own separately from any other account of the Fund you may own) falls below the minimum initial investment requirement applicable to you for any reason, including as a result of market decline, your account generally will be subject to a $20 annual fee. This fee will be assessed through the automatic sale of Fund shares in your account. Any otherwise applicable CDSC will not be imposed on such an automatic sale of your shares. The Transfer Agent will reduce the expenses paid by the Fund by any amounts it collects from the assessment of this fee. For Funds that do not have transfer agency expenses against which to offset the amount collected through assessment of this fee, the fee will be paid directly to the Fund.

 

C-28


Table of Contents

The Transfer Agent will send you written notification in advance of assessing any fee, which will provide details on how you can avoid the imposition of such fee. Generally, you may avoid the imposition of such fee by raising your Fund account balance, consolidating your Fund accounts through an exchange of shares of another Fund in which you hold shares, or setting up a Systematic Investment Plan. For more information, contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. The Transfer Agent’s contact information (toll-free number and mailing address) as well as the Funds’ website address can be found at the beginning of the section Choosing a Share Class.

Each Fund reserves the right to change its minimum investment requirements. The Funds also reserve the right to lower the account size trigger point for the minimum balance fee in any year or for any class of shares when we believe it is appropriate to do so in light of declines in the market value of Fund shares, sales loads applicable to a particular class of shares, or for other reasons.

Exceptions to the Small Account Policy (Accounts Below $250 and Minimum Balance Fee)

The automatic sale of Fund shares of accounts under $250 and the annual minimum balance fee described above do not apply to shareholders of Class E, Class F, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class Y or Class W shares; shareholders holding their shares through broker/dealer networked accounts; wrap fee and omnibus accounts; accounts with active Systematic Investment Plans; certain qualified retirement plans; and health savings accounts. The automatic sale of Fund shares of accounts under $250 does not apply to individual retirement plans.

Small Account Policy — Broker/Dealer and Wrap Fee Accounts

The Funds may automatically redeem at any time broker/dealer networked accounts and wrap fee accounts that have account balances of $20 or less or have less than one share.

Cash Flows

The timing and magnitude of cash inflows from investors buying Fund shares could prevent the Fund from always being fully invested. Conversely, the timing and magnitude of cash outflows to investors redeeming Fund shares could require large ready reserves of uninvested cash to meet shareholder redemptions. Either situation could adversely impact the Fund’s performance.

Information Sharing Agreements

As required by Rule 22c-2 under the 1940 Act, the Funds or certain of their service providers will enter into information sharing agreements with selling and/or servicing agents, including participating life insurance companies and financial intermediaries that sponsor or offer retirement plans through which shares of the Funds are made available for purchase. Pursuant to Rule 22c-2, selling and/or servicing agents are required, upon request, to: (i) provide shareholder account and transaction information and (ii) execute instructions from the Fund to restrict or prohibit further purchases of Fund shares by shareholders who have been identified by the Fund as having engaged in transactions that violate the Fund’s excessive trading policies and procedures. See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Excessive Trading Practices for more information.

Excessive Trading Practices Policy of Non-Money Market Funds

Right to Reject or Restrict Share Transaction Orders — The Fund is intended for investors with long-term investment purposes and is not intended as a vehicle for frequent trading activity (market timing) that is excessive. Investors should transact in Fund shares primarily for investment purposes. The Board has adopted excessive trading policies and procedures that are designed to deter excessive trading by investors (the Excessive Trading Policies and Procedures). The Fund discourages and does not accommodate excessive trading.

The Fund reserves the right to reject, without any prior notice, any buy or exchange order for any reason, and will not be liable for any loss resulting from rejected orders. For example, the Fund may in its discretion restrict or reject a buy or exchange order even if the transaction is not subject to the specific exchange limitation described below if the Fund or its agents determine that accepting the order could interfere with efficient management of the Fund’s portfolio or is otherwise contrary to the Fund’s best interests. The Excessive Trading Policies and Procedures apply equally to buy or exchange transactions communicated directly to the Transfer Agent and to those received by selling and/or servicing agents.

Specific Buying and Exchanging Limitations — If a Fund detects that an investor has made two “material round trips” in any 28-day period, it will generally reject the investor’s future buy orders, including exchange buy orders, involving any Fund.

For these purposes, a “round trip” is a purchase or exchange into the Fund followed by a sale or exchange out of the Fund, or a sale or exchange out of the Fund followed by a purchase or exchange into the Fund. A “material” round trip is one that is deemed by the Fund to be material in terms of its amount or its potential detrimental impact on the Fund. Independent of this limit, the Fund may, in its discretion, reject future buy orders by any person, group or account that appears to have engaged in any type of excessive trading activity.

 

C-29


Table of Contents

 

These limits generally do not apply to automated transactions or transactions by registered investment companies that invest in the Fund using a “fund-of-funds” structure. These limits do not apply to payroll deduction contributions by retirement plan participants, transactions initiated by a retirement plan sponsor or certain other retirement plan transactions consisting of rollover transactions, loan repayments and disbursements, and required minimum distribution redemptions. They may be modified or rescinded for accounts held by certain retirement plans to conform to plan limits, for considerations relating to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or regulations of the Department of Labor, and for certain asset allocation or wrap programs. Accounts known to be under common ownership or control generally will be counted together, but accounts maintained or managed by a common intermediary generally will not be considered to be under common ownership or control. The Fund retains the right to modify these restrictions at any time without prior notice to shareholders.

Limitations on the Ability to Detect and Prevent Excessive Trading Practices — The Fund takes various steps designed to detect and prevent excessive trading, including daily review of available shareholder transaction information. However, the Fund receives buy, sell and exchange orders through selling and/or servicing agents, and cannot always know of or reasonably detect excessive trading that may be facilitated by selling and/or servicing agents or by the use of the omnibus account arrangements they offer. Omnibus account arrangements are common forms of holding shares of mutual funds, particularly among certain selling and/or servicing agents such as broker/dealers, retirement plans and variable insurance products. These arrangements often permit selling and/or servicing agents to aggregate their clients’ transactions and accounts, and in these circumstances, the identity of the shareholders is often not known to the Fund.

Some selling and/or servicing agents apply their own restrictions or policies to underlying investor accounts, which may be more or less restrictive than those described here. This may impact the Fund’s ability to curtail excessive trading, even where it is identified. For these and other reasons, it is possible that excessive trading may occur despite the Fund’s efforts to detect and prevent it.

Although these restrictions and policies involve judgments that are inherently subjective and may involve some selectivity in their application, the Fund seeks to act in a manner that it believes is consistent with the best interests of shareholders in making any such judgments.

Risks of Excessive Trading — Excessive trading creates certain risks to the Fund’s long-term shareholders and may create the following adverse effects:

 

 

negative impact on the Fund’s performance;

 

 

potential dilution of the value of the Fund’s shares;

 

 

interference with the efficient management of the Fund’s portfolio, such as the need to maintain undesirably large cash positions, the need to use its line of credit or the need to buy or sell securities it otherwise would not have bought or sold;

 

 

losses on the sale of investments resulting from the need to sell securities at less favorable prices;

 

 

increased taxable gains to the Fund’s remaining shareholders resulting from the need to sell securities to meet sell orders; and

 

 

increased brokerage and administrative costs.

To the extent that the Fund invests significantly in foreign securities traded on markets that close before the Fund’s valuation time, it may be particularly susceptible to dilution as a result of excessive trading. Because events may occur after the close of foreign markets and before the Fund’s valuation time that influence the value of foreign securities, investors may seek to trade Fund shares in an effort to benefit from their understanding of the value of foreign securities as of the Fund’s valuation time. This is often referred to as price arbitrage. The Fund has adopted procedures designed to adjust closing market prices of foreign securities under certain circumstances to reflect what the Fund believes to be the fair value of those securities as of its valuation time. To the extent the adjustments don’t work fully, investors engaging in price arbitrage may cause dilution in the value of the Fund’s shares held by other shareholders.

Similarly, to the extent that the Fund invests significantly in thinly traded high-yield bonds (junk bonds) or equity securities of small-capitalization companies, because these securities are often traded infrequently, investors may seek to trade their shares in an effort to benefit from their understanding of the value of these securities. This is also a type of price arbitrage. Any such frequent trading strategies may interfere with efficient management of the Fund’s portfolio to a greater degree than would be the case for mutual funds that invest in highly liquid securities, in part because the Fund may have difficulty selling those portfolio securities at advantageous times or prices to satisfy large and/or frequent sell orders. Any successful price arbitrage may also cause dilution in the value of Fund shares held by other shareholders.

Excessive Trading Practices Policy of Money Market Funds

The money market Funds are designed to offer investors a liquid cash option that they may buy and sell as often as they wish. Accordingly, the Board has not adopted policies and procedures designed to discourage excessive or short-term trading of money market Fund shares. However, since frequent purchases and sales of money market Fund shares could in certain instances harm shareholders in various ways, including reducing the returns to long-term shareholders by increasing costs (such as spreads paid to dealers who trade money market instruments with the money market Funds) and disrupting portfolio management strategies, each of

 

C-30


Table of Contents

the money market Funds reserves the right, but has no obligation, to reject any purchase or exchange transaction at any time. Except as expressly described herein (such as minimum purchase amounts), the money market Funds have no limits on buy or exchange transactions. In addition, each of the money market Funds reserve the right to impose or modify restrictions on purchases, exchanges or trading of the Fund shares at any time.

Opening an Account and Placing Orders

We encourage you to consult with a financial advisor who can help you with your investment decisions and who can help you open an account. Once you have an account, you can buy, sell and exchange shares by contacting your financial advisor who will send your order to the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. As described in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies, once you have an account you can also communicate your orders directly to the Transfer Agent by mail, by telephone or online.

The Funds are available directly and through broker-dealers, banks and other selling and/or servicing agents or institutions, and through certain qualified and non-qualified plans, wrap fee products or other investment products sponsored by selling and/or servicing agents.

Not all selling and/or servicing agents offer the Funds and certain selling and/or servicing agents that offer the Funds may not offer all Funds on all investment platforms. Please consult with your financial advisor to determine the availability of the Funds. If you set up an account at a selling and/or servicing agent that does not have, and is unable to obtain, a selling agreement with the Distributor, you will not be able to transfer Fund holdings to that account. In that event, you must either maintain your Fund holdings with your current selling and/or servicing agent, find another selling and/or servicing agent with a selling agreement, or sell your Fund shares, paying any applicable CDSC. Please be aware that transactions in taxable accounts are taxable events and may result in income tax liability.

Selling and/or servicing agents that offer the Funds may charge you additional fees for the services they provide and they may have different policies not described herein. Some policy differences may include different minimum investment amounts, exchange privileges, Fund choices and cutoff times for investments. Additionally, recordkeeping, transaction processing and payments of distributions relating to your account may be performed by the selling and/or servicing agents through which your shares of the Fund are held. Since the Fund (and its service providers) may not have a record of your account transactions, you should always contact the financial advisor employed by the selling and/or servicing agent through which you purchased or at which you maintain your shares of the Fund to make changes to your account or to give instructions concerning your account, or to obtain information about your account. The Fund and its service providers, including the Distributor and the Transfer Agent, are not responsible for the failure of one of these financial intermediaries and/or its selling and/or servicing agents to carry out its obligations to its customers.

As stated above, you may establish and maintain your account with a selling and/or servicing agent authorized by the Distributor to sell fund shares or directly with the Fund. The Fund may engage selling and/or servicing agents to receive purchase orders and exchange (and sale) orders on its behalf. Accounts established directly with the Fund will be serviced by the Transfer Agent. The Funds, the Transfer Agent and the Distributor do not provide investment advice. The Funds encourage you to consult with a financial advisor who can help you with your investment decisions and who can help you open an account. Once you have an account, you can buy, sell and exchange shares by contacting your financial advisor who will send your order to the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. As described in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies, once you have an account you can also communicate your orders directly to the Transfer Agent.

Accounts established directly with the Fund

You or the financial advisor through which you buy shares may establish an account with the Fund. To do so, complete a Fund account application with your financial advisor or investment professional, and mail the account application to the address below. Account applications may be obtained at columbiamanagement.com or may be requested by calling 800.345.6611. Make your check payable to the Fund. You will be assessed a $15 fee for any checks rejected by your financial institution due to insufficient funds or other reasons. The Funds do not accept cash, credit card convenience checks, money orders, traveler’s checks, starter checks, third or fourth party checks, or other cash equivalents.

Mail your check and completed application to The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (regular mail) P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 or (express mail) 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809. You may also use these addresses to request an exchange or redemption of Fund shares.

You will be sent a statement confirming your purchase and any subsequent transactions in your account. You will also be sent quarterly and annual statements detailing your transactions in the Fund and the other Funds you own under the same account number. Duplicate quarterly account statements for the current year and duplicate annual statements for the most recent prior calendar year will be sent to you free of charge. Copies of year-end statements for prior years are available for a fee. Please contact the Transfer Agent for more information.

 

C-31


Table of Contents

 

Buying Shares

Eligible Investors

Class A and Class C Shares

Class A and Class C shares are available to the general public for investment. Once you have opened an account, you can buy Class A and Class C shares in a lump sum, through our Systematic Investment Plan, by dividend diversification, by wire or by electronic funds transfer. For money market Funds, new investments must be made in Class A, Class I (available as a new investment only to the Funds (i.e., Fund-of-Fund investment)), Class T, Class W or Class Z shares of the Fund, subject to eligibility. Class C and Class R of the money market Funds are available as a new investment only to investors in the Distributor’s proprietary 401(k) products, provided that such investor is eligible to invest in the Class and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper. The money market Funds offer other classes of shares only to facilitate exchanges with other Funds offering these classes of shares.

Class B Shares Closed

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions involving existing investors in Class B shares as described in more detail below.

Additional Class B shares will be issued only to existing investors in Class B shares and only through the following two types of transactions (Qualifying Transactions):

 

 

Dividends and/or capital gain distributions may continue to be reinvested in Class B shares of a Fund.

 

 

Shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Fund may exchange those shares for Class B shares of other Funds offering such shares. Certain exceptions apply, including that not all Funds may permit exchanges.

Any initial purchase orders for the Fund’s Class B shares will be rejected (other than through a Qualifying Transaction that is an exchange transaction).

Unless contrary instructions are received in advance by the Fund, any purchase orders (except those submitted by a selling and/or servicing agent through the National Securities Clearing Corporation (NSCC) as described in more detail below) that are initial investments in Class B shares or that are orders for additional Class B shares of the Fund received from existing investors in Class B shares, including orders made through an active systematic investment plan, will automatically be invested in Class A shares of the Fund, without regard to the normal minimum initial investment requirement for Class A shares, but subject to the front-end sales charge that generally applies to Class A shares. For additional information about Class A shares, see Choosing a Share Class – Class A Shares – Front-end Sales Charges. Your selling and/or servicing agent may have different policies not described here, including a policy to reject purchase orders for a Fund’s Class B shares or to automatically invest the purchase amount in a money market fund. Please consult your selling and/or servicing agent to understand their policy.

Additional purchase orders for a Fund’s Class B shares by an existing Class B shareholder, submitted by such shareholder’s selling and/or servicing agent through the NSCC, will be rejected due to operational limitations of the NSCC. Investors should consult their selling and/or servicing agent if they wish to invest in the Fund by purchasing a share class of the Fund other than Class B shares.

Dividend and/or capital gain distributions from Class B shares of a Fund will not be automatically invested in Class B shares of another Fund. Unless contrary instructions are received in advance of the date of declaration, such dividend and/or capital gain distributions from Class B shares of a Fund will be reinvested in Class B shares of the same Fund that is making the distribution.

Class E and Class F Shares Closed

Class E and Class F shares are closed to new investors and new accounts. Shareholders who opened and funded an account with the Fund as of September 22, 2006 (including accounts once funded that subsequently reached a zero balance) (i) may continue to make additional purchases of Class E and Class F shares and (ii) will continue to have their dividend and capital gains distributions reinvested. These share classes are designed for investors who wish to make an irrevocable gift to a child, grandchild or other individual. Shares are held in an irrevocable trust until a specified date, at which time they pass to a beneficiary.

Class I Shares

Class I shares are currently only available to the Funds (i.e., Fund of Fund investments). Class I shares may be purchased, sold or exchanged only through the Distributor or an authorized selling and/or servicing agent. The Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments in Class I shares from other institutional investors.

Class R Shares

Class R shares can only be bought through eligible health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Ameriprise Financial affiliates, and the following eligible retirement plans: 401(k) plans; 457 plans; employer-sponsored

 

C-32


Table of Contents

 

403(b) plans; profit sharing and money purchase pension plans; defined benefit plans; and non-qualified deferred compensation plans. Class R shares are not available for investment through retail nonretirement accounts, traditional and Roth IRAs, Coverdell Education Savings Accounts, SEPs, SAR-SEPs, Simple IRAs, individual 403(b) plans or 529 tuition programs. Contact the Transfer Agent or your retirement plan or health savings account administrator for more information about investing in Class R shares. The Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments in Class R shares from other institutional investors.

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 Shares

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are closed to new investors and new accounts effective as of the close of business on December 31, 2010, subject to certain limited exceptions described below.

Shareholders who opened and funded a Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 account with the Fund as of the close of business on December 31, 2010 (including accounts once funded that subsequently reached a zero balance) may continue to make additional purchases of these share classes. Plans may continue to make additional purchases of Fund shares and add new participants, and new plans sponsored by the same or an affiliated sponsor may invest in the Fund (and add new participants) if an initial plan so sponsored invested in the Fund as of December 31, 2010 (or has approved the Fund as an investment option as of December 31, 2010 and funds its initial account with the Fund prior to March 31, 2011) and holds Fund shares at the plan level.

In the event that an order to purchase Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 shares is received by the Fund or the Transfer Agent after the close of business on December 31, 2010 (other than as described above) from a new investor or a new account that is not eligible to purchase shares, that order will be refused by the Fund and the Transfer Agent and any money that the Fund or the Transfer Agent received with the order will be returned to the investor or the selling and/or servicing agent, as appropriate, without interest.

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are designed for qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, charitable organizations that meet the definition in Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, state sponsored college savings plans established under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code, and health savings accounts created pursuant to public law 108-173. Additionally, if approved by the Distributor, Class R5 shares are available to institutional or corporate accounts above a threshold established by the Distributor (currently $1 million per Fund or $10 million in all Funds) and bank trust departments. Class R3, Class R4 and R5 shares may be purchased, sold or exchanged only through the Distributor or an authorized selling and/or servicing agent. Class R3, Class R4 shares and Class R5 shares of the Fund may be exchanged for Class R3 shares, Class R4 shares and Class R5 shares, respectively, of another Fund.

Class T Shares Closed

Class T shares are available for purchase only to investors who received (and who have continuously held) Class T shares in connection with the merger of certain Galaxy funds into various Columbia funds (formerly named Liberty funds).

Class W Shares

Class W shares are available to investors purchasing through authorized investment programs managed by investment professionals, including discretionary managed account programs. Class W shares may be purchased, sold or exchanged only through the Distributor or an authorized selling and/or servicing agent. Shares originally purchased in a discretionary managed account may continue to be held in Class W outside of a discretionary managed account, but no additional Class W purchases may be made and no exchanges to Class W shares of another Fund may be made outside of a discretionary managed account. The Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments in Class W shares from other institutional investors.

Class Y Shares

Class Y shares are available only to the following categories of eligible investors:

 

 

Individual investors and institutional clients (endowments, foundations, defined benefit plans, etc.) who invest at least $1 million in Class Y shares of a single Fund; and

 

 

Group retirement plans (including 401(k) plans, 457 plans, employer-sponsored 403(b) plans, profit sharing and money purchase plans) with plan assets of at least $10 million.

Currently, Class Y shares are offered only to certain former shareholders of the series of the former Columbia Funds Institutional Trust and to institutional and high net worth individuals and clients invested in certain pooled investment vehicles and separate accounts managed by the investment manager.

 

C-33


Table of Contents

 

Class Z Shares

Class Z shares are available only to the categories of eligible investors described below under “Minimum Investment and Account Balance – Class Z Shares Minimum Investments”

In addition, for Class I, Class R, Class W, Class Y and Class Z shares, the Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments from other institutional investors not listed above.

Minimum Initial Investments, Additional Investments and Account Balances

The table below shows the Fund’s minimum initial investment, additional investment and minimum account balance requirements, which may vary by Fund, class and type of account.

 

Minimum Investment and Account Balance   
     Minimum Initial
investment
    Minimum
Additional
investments
     Minimum
Account balance
 

For all Funds, classes and accounts except those listed below

(non-qualified)

     $2,000 (a)      $100         $250 (d) 

Individual Retirement Accounts

     $1,000        $100         none   

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund,

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund,

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

     $10,000        $100         $5,000   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund,

Columbia Floating Rate Fund,

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

     $5,000        $100         $2,500   

Class I, Class R

     none        none         none   

Class W

     $500        none         $500   

Class Y

     variable (b)      $100         $250   

Class Z

     variable (a)(c)      $100         $250 (d) 

 

(a)

If your Class A, B, C, T or Z shares account balance falls below the minimum initial investment amount for any reason, including a market decline, you may be asked to increase it to the minimum initial investment amount or establish a systematic investment plan. If you do not do so, it will be subject to a $20 annual low balance fee and/or shares may be automatically redeemed and the proceeds mailed to you if the account falls below the minimum account balance requirement.

(b)

The minimum initial investment amount for Class Y shares varies depending on eligibility. For eligibility details, see Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Buying Shares – Eligible Investors – Class Y Shares.

(c)

The minimum initial investment requirement for Class Z shares is $0, $1,000 or $2,000 depending upon the category of eligible investor. For details, see Class Z Shares Minimum Investments below.

(d)

If the value of your account falls below $250, your Fund account is subject to automatic redemption of Fund shares. For details, see Small Account Policy above.

Systematic Investment Plan

The Systematic Investment Plan allows you to make regular purchases via automatic transfers from your bank account to the Fund on a monthly, quarterly or semi-annual basis. Contact the Transfer Agent or your financial advisor to set up the plan. The table below shows the minimum initial investments, minimum additional investments and minimum account balance for investment through a Systematic Investment Plan:

 

C-34


Table of Contents

 

Minimum Investment and Account Balance — Systematic Investment Plans   
     Minimum Initial
investment
    Minimum
Additional
investments
     Minimum
Account balance*
 

For all Funds, classes and accounts except those listed below

(non-qualified)

     $100 *(a)      $100         none *(b) 

Individual Retirement Accounts

     $100 *(b)      $50         none   

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund,

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund,

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

     $10,000        $100         $5,000   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund,

Columbia Floating Rate Fund,

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

     $5,000        $100         $2,500   

Class I, Class R

     none        none         none   

Class W

     $500        none         $500   

Class Y

     variable (c)      $100         none   

Class Z

     variable (d)      $100         none   

 

* If your Fund account balance is below the minimum initial investment requirement described in this table, you must make investments at least monthly, as follows:
  (a) money market Funds – $2,000; and
  (b) money market Funds – $1,000.
(c)

The minimum initial investment amount for Class Y shares varies depending on eligibility. For eligibility details, see Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Buying Shares – Eligible Investors – Class Y Shares.

(d)

The minimum initial investment requirement for Class Z shares is $0, $1,000 or $2,000 depending upon the category of eligible investor. For details, see Class Z Shares Minimum Investments below.

Class Z Shares Minimum Investments

There is no minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following categories of eligible investors:

 

 

Any person investing all or part of the proceeds of a distribution, rollover or transfer of assets into a Columbia Management Individual Retirement Account, from any deferred compensation plan which was a shareholder of any of the Funds of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000, in which the investor was a participant and through which the investor invested in one or more of the Funds of Columbia Acorn Trust immediately prior to the distribution, transfer or rollover.

 

 

Any health savings account sponsored by a third party platform and any omnibus group retirement plan for which a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity provides services and is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than in the form of payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent.

 

 

Any investor participating in a wrap program sponsored by a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity that is paid an asset-based fee by the investor and that is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent.

The minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following eligible investors is $1,000:

 

 

Any individual retirement plan (assuming the eligibility criteria below are met) or group retirement plan that is not held in an omnibus manner for which a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity provides services and is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than in the form of payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent.

 

 

Any person employed as of April 30, 2010 by the former investment manager, distributor or transfer agent of the Legacy Columbia funds is eligible to make new and subsequent purchases in the Class Z shares through an individual retirement account.

 

C-35


Table of Contents

 

The minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following categories of eligible investors is $2,000:

 

 

Any investor buying shares through a Columbia Management state tuition plan organized under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code.

 

 

Any shareholder (as well as any family member of a shareholder or person listed on an account registration for any account of the shareholder) of another fund distributed by the Distributor (i) who holds Class Z shares; (ii) who held Primary A shares prior to the share class redesignation of Primary A shares as Class Z shares that occurred on August 22, 2005; (iii) who holds Class A shares that were obtained by an exchange of Class Z shares; or (iv) who bought shares of certain mutual funds that were not subject to sales charges and that merged with a Legacy Columbia fund distributed by the Distributor.

 

 

Any trustee or director (or family member of a trustee or director) of a fund distributed by the Distributor.

 

 

Any investor participating in an account offered by a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity that provides services to such an account, is paid an asset-based fee by the investor and is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent (each investor buying shares through a selling and/or servicing agent must independently satisfy the minimum investment requirement noted above).

 

 

Any institutional investor who is a corporation, partnership, trust, foundation, endowment, institution, government entity, or similar organization, which meets the respective qualifications for an accredited investor, as defined under the Securities Act of 1933.

 

 

Certain financial institutions and intermediaries, such as insurance companies, trust companies, banks, endowments, investment companies or foundations, buying shares for their own account, including Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates and/or subsidiaries.

 

 

Any person employed as of April 30, 2010 by the former investment manager, distributor or transfer agent of the Legacy Columbia funds is eligible to make new and subsequent purchases in the Class Z shares through a non-retirement account.

 

 

Certain other investors as set forth in more detail in the Merger SAI.

The minimum initial investment requirements may be waived for accounts that are managed by an investment professional, for accounts held in approved discretionary or non-discretionary wrap programs, for accounts that are a part of an employer-sponsored retirement plan, or for other account types if approved by the Distributor.

The Fund reserves the right to modify its minimum investment and related requirements at any time, with or without prior notice.

Dividend Diversification

Generally, you may automatically invest distributions made by another Fund into the same class of shares (and in some cases certain other classes of shares) of the Fund at no additional sales charge. A sales charge may apply when you invest distributions made with respect to shares that were not subject to a sales charge at the time of your initial purchase. Call the Funds at 800.345.6611 for details. See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders – Buying Shares – Class B Shares Closed for restrictions applicable to Class B shares.

Wire Purchases

You may buy Class A, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shares of the Fund by wiring money from your bank account to your Fund account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.345.6611.

Electronic Funds Transfer

You may buy Class A, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shares of the Fund by electronically transferring money from your bank account to your Fund account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. An electronic funds transfer may take up to three business days to settle and be considered in “good form.” You must set up this feature by contacting the Transfer Agent prior to your request to obtain any necessary forms. The minimum investment amount for additional purchases via electronic funds transfer is $100.

Important: Payments sent by electronic fund transfers, a bank authorization, or check that are not guaranteed may take up to 10 or more days to clear. If you request a redemption before the purchase funds clear, this may cause your redemption request to fail to process if the requested amount includes unguaranteed funds. If you purchased your shares by check or from your bank account as an Automated Clearing House (ACH) transaction, the Fund holds the redemption proceeds when you sell those shares for a period of time after the trade date of the purchase.

Other Purchase Rules You Should Know

 

 

Once the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your buy order in “good form,” your purchase will be made at the next calculated public offering price per share, which is the net asset value per share plus any sales charge that applies.

 

C-36


Table of Contents

 

 

You generally buy Class A, Class E and Class T shares at the public offering price per share because purchases of these share classes are generally subject to a front-end sales charge.

 

 

You buy Class B, Class C, Class F, Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class W, Class Y and Class Z shares at net asset value per share because no front-end sales charge applies to purchases of these share classes.

 

 

The Fund reserves the right to cancel your order if it doesn’t receive payment within three business days of receiving your buy order. The Fund will return any payment received for orders that have been cancelled, but no interest will be paid on that money.

 

 

Selling and/or servicing agents are responsible for sending your buy orders to the Transfer Agent and ensuring that we receive your money on time.

 

 

Shares bought are recorded on the books of the Fund. The Fund doesn’t issue certificates.

Selling Shares

When you sell your shares, the Fund is effectively buying them back from you. This is called a redemption. You may sell your shares at any time. The payment will be sent within seven days after your request is received in good order. When you sell shares, the amount you receive may be more or less than the amount you invested. Your sale price will be the next NAV calculated after your request is received in good order, minus any applicable CDSC.

Remember that Class R, R3, R4 and R5 shares are sold through your eligible retirement plan or health savings account. For detailed rules regarding the sale of these classes of shares, contact the Transfer Agent, your retirement plan or health savings account administrator.

Wire Redemptions

You may request that your Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class I, Class T, Class W, Class Y and Class Z share sale proceeds be wired to your bank account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. You must set up this feature prior to your request. The Transfer Agent charges a fee for shares sold by Fedwire. The Transfer Agent may waive the fee for certain accounts. The receiving bank may charge an additional fee. The minimum amount that can be redeemed by wire is $500.

Electronic Funds Transfer

You may sell Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shares of the Fund and request that the proceeds be electronically transferred to your bank account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. It may take up to three business days for the sale proceeds to be received by your bank. You must set up this feature by contacting the Transfer Agent prior to your request to obtain any necessary forms.

Systematic Withdrawal Plan

The Systematic Withdrawal Plan lets you withdraw funds from your Class A, Class B, Class C, Class I, Class T, Class W, Class Y and/or Class Z shares account any day of the month on a monthly, quarterly or semi-annual basis. Contact the Transfer Agent or your financial advisor to set up the plan. To set up the plan, your account balance must meet the Fund Class’ minimum initial investment amount. All dividend and capital gain distributions must be reinvested to set up the plan. A Systematic Withdrawal Plan cannot be set up on an account that already has a Systematic Investment Plan established. If you set up the plan after you’ve opened your account, we may require your signature to be Medallion Signature Guaranteed.

You can choose to receive your withdrawals via check or direct deposit into your bank account. Otherwise, the Fund will deduct any applicable CDSC from the withdrawals before sending the balance to you. You can cancel the plan by giving the Fund 30 days notice in writing or by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. It’s important to remember that if you withdraw more than your investment in the Fund is earning, you’ll eventually use up your original investment.

Check Redemption Service

Class A shares of the money market Funds offer check writing privileges. If you have $2,000 in a money market Fund, you may request checks which may be drawn against your account. The amount of any check drawn against your money market Fund must be at least $100. You can elect this service on your initial application or thereafter. Call 800.345.6611 for the appropriate forms to establish this service. If you own Class A shares that were both in another Fund at NAV because of the size of the purchase, and then exchanged into a money market Fund, check redemptions may be subject to a CDSC. A $15 charge will be assessed for any stop payment order requested by you or any overdraft in connection with checks written against your money market Fund account.

 

C-37


Table of Contents

 

In-Kind Distributions

The Fund reserves the right to honor sell orders with in-kind distributions of portfolio securities instead of cash. In the event the Fund makes such an in-kind distribution, you may incur the brokerage and transaction costs associated with converting the portfolio securities you receive into cash. Also, the portfolio securities you receive may increase or decrease in value before you convert them into cash.

Other Redemption Rules You Should Know

 

 

Once the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your sell order in “good form,” your shares will be sold at the next calculated net asset value per share. Any applicable CDSC will be deducted from the amount you’re selling and the balance will be remitted to you.

 

 

If you sell your shares directly through the Funds, we will normally send the sale proceeds by mail or electronically transfer them to your bank account within three business days after the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your order in “good form.”

 

 

If you sell your shares through a selling and/or servicing agent, the Funds will normally send the sale proceeds by Fedwire within three business days after the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your order in “good form.”

 

 

If you paid for your shares by check or from your bank account as an Automated Clearing House (ACH) transaction, the Funds will hold the sale proceeds when you sell those shares for a period of time after the trade date of the purchase.

 

 

No interest will be paid on uncashed redemption checks.

 

 

The Funds can delay payment of the redemption proceeds for up to seven days and may suspend redemptions and/or further postpone payment of redemption proceeds when the NYSE is closed or during emergency circumstances as determined by the SEC.

 

 

Other restrictions may apply to retirement accounts. For information about these restrictions, contact your retirement plan administrator.

 

 

Also keep in mind the Funds’ Small Account Policy, which is described above in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies.

 

 

For Class E shareholders, if, at the time of the trust’s termination, the beneficiary does not elect to redeem Class E shares held by the trust, the shares automatically will convert to Class A shares of the Fund and be registered in the beneficiary’s name. For Class F shareholders, if, at the time of the trust’s termination, the beneficiary does not elect to redeem Class F shares held by the trust, the shares automatically will convert to Class B shares of the Fund and be registered in the beneficiary’s name. After such conversion, the beneficiary’s shares no longer will convert to Class E shares, but will convert to Class A shares in accordance with the applicable conversion schedule for Class B shares. Automatic conversion of Class B shares to Class A shares occurs eight years after purchase for these shares. For purposes of calculating the conversion period, the beneficiary ownership period for the Class B shares will begin at the time the Class F shares were purchased.

 

 

For Class E and Class F shareholders, if the beneficiary under a Columbia Advantage Plan trust exercises his or her withdrawal rights, the financial advisor may be required to refund to the Distributor any sales charge or initial commission previously retained or paid on the withdrawn Class E and/or Class F shares or amount redeemed.

Exchanging Shares

You can generally sell shares of a Fund to buy shares of another Fund, in what is called an exchange. You should read the prospectus of, and make sure you understand the investment objective, principal investment strategies, risks, fees and expenses of, the Fund into which you are exchanging. You may be subject to a sales charge if you exchange from a money market Fund or any other Fund that does not charge a front-end sales charge into a non-money market Fund. If you hold your Fund shares through certain selling and/or servicing agents, including Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., you may have limited exchangeability among the Funds. Please contact your financial advisor for more information.

Systematic Exchanges

You may buy Class A, Class C, Class T, Class W, Class Y and/or Class Z shares of a Fund by exchanging each month from another Fund for shares of the same class of the Fund at no additional cost, subject to the following exchange amount minimums: $50 each month for individual retirement accounts (i.e. tax qualified accounts); and $100 each month for non-retirement accounts. Contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent to set up the plan. If you set up your plan to exchange more than $100,000 each month, you must obtain a Medallion Signature Guarantee.

Exchanges will continue as long as your balance is sufficient to complete the systematic monthly transfers, subject to the Funds’ Small Account Policy described above in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies. You may terminate the program or change the amount you would like to exchange (subject to the $50 and $100 minimum requirements noted immediately above) by calling the Funds at 800.345.6611. A sales charge may apply when you exchange shares of a Fund that were not assessed a sales charge at the time of your initial purchase.

The rules described below for making exchanges apply to systematic exchanges.

 

C-38


Table of Contents

 

Other Exchange Rules You Should Know

 

 

Exchanges are made at net asset value next calculated after your exchange order is received in good form.

 

 

Once the Fund receives your exchange request, you cannot cancel it after the market closes.

 

 

The rules for buying shares of a Fund generally apply to exchanges into that Fund, including, if your exchange creates a new Fund account, it must satisfy the minimum investment amount, unless a waiver applies.

 

 

Shares of the purchased Fund may not be used on the same day for another exchange or sale.

 

 

You can generally make exchanges between like share classes of any Fund. Some exceptions apply.

 

 

If you exchange shares from Class A shares of a money market Fund to a non-money market Fund, any further exchanges must be between shares of the same class. For example, if you exchange from Class A shares of a money market Fund into Class C shares of a non-money market Fund, you may not exchange from Class C shares of that non-money market Fund back to Class A shares of a money market Fund.

 

 

A sales charge may apply when you exchange shares of a Fund that were not assessed a sales charge at the time of your initial purchase. If your initial investment was in a money market Fund and you exchange into a non-money market Fund, your transaction is subject to a front-end sales charge if you exchange into Class A shares and to a CDSC if you exchange into Class C, Class E, Class F and Class T shares of the Funds.

 

 

If your initial investment was in Class A shares of a non-money market Fund and you exchange shares into a money market Fund, you may exchange that amount to another Fund, including dividends earned on that amount, without paying a sales charge.

 

 

If your shares are subject to a CDSC, you will not be charged a CDSC upon the exchange of those shares. Any CDSC will be deducted when you sell the shares you received from the exchange. The CDSC imposed at that time will be based on the period that begins when you bought shares of the original Fund and ends when you sell the shares of the Fund you received from the exchange. The applicable CDSC will be the CDSC of the original Fund.

 

 

Class T shares may be exchanged for Class T or Class A shares. Class T shares exchanged into Class A shares cannot be exchanged back into Class T shares.

 

 

Class Z shares of a Fund may be exchanged for Class A or Class Z shares of another Fund.

 

 

You may make exchanges only into a Fund that is legally offered and sold in your state of residence. Contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent for more information.

 

 

You generally may make an exchange only into a Fund that is accepting investments.

 

 

The Fund may change or cancel your right to make an exchange by giving the amount of notice required by regulatory authorities (generally 60 days for a material change or cancellation).

 

 

Unless your account is part of a tax-advantaged arrangement, an exchange for shares of another Fund is a taxable event, and you may recognize a gain or loss for tax purposes.

 

 

Shares of Class W originally purchased, but no longer held in a discretionary managed account, may not be exchanged for Class W shares of another Fund. You may continue to hold these shares in the original Fund. Changing your investment to a different Fund will be treated as a sale and purchase, and you will be subject to applicable taxes on the sale and sales charges on the purchase of the new Fund.

You may exchange or sell shares by having your selling and/or servicing agent process your transaction. If you maintain your account directly with your selling and/or servicing agent, you must contact that agent to exchange or sell shares of the Fund. If your account was established directly with the Fund, there are a variety of methods you may use to exchange or sell shares of the Fund.

Same-Fund Exchange Privilege for Class Z Shares

Certain shareholders invested in a class of shares other than Class Z may become eligible to invest in Class Z shares. Upon a determination of such eligibility, any such shareholders will be eligible to exchange their shares for Class Z shares of the same Fund, if offered. No sales charges or other charges will apply to any such exchange, except that when Class B shares are exchanged for Class Z shares, any CDSC charges applicable to Class B shares will be applied. Ordinarily, shareholders will not recognize a gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon such an exchange. Investors should contact their selling and/or servicing agents to learn more about the details of the Class Z shares exchange privilege.

Ways to Request a Sale or Exchange of Shares

Account established with your selling and/or servicing agent

You can exchange or sell Fund shares by having your financial advisor or selling and/or servicing agent process your transaction. They may have different policies not described herein, including different transaction limits, exchange policies and sale procedures.

 

C-39


Table of Contents

 

Mail your sale or exchange request to The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (regular mail) P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 or (express mail) 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809.

Include in your letter: your name; the name of the Fund(s); your account number; the class of shares to be exchanged or sold; your social security number (SSN) or taxpayer identification number (TIN); the dollar amount or number of shares you want to exchange or sell; specific instructions regarding delivery or exchange destination; signature(s) of registered account owner(s); and any special documents the Transfer Agent may require in order to process your order.

Corporate, trust or partnership accounts may need to send additional documents. Payment will be mailed to the address of record and made payable to the names listed on the account, unless your request specifies differently and is signed by all owners.

Distributions and Taxes

Distributions to Shareholders

A mutual fund can make money two ways:

 

 

It can earn income on its investments. Examples of fund income are interest paid on money market instruments and bonds, and dividends paid on common stocks.

 

 

A mutual fund can also have capital gains if the value of its investments increases. While a fund continues to hold an investment, any gain is unrealized. If the fund sells an investment, it generally will realize a capital gain if it sells that investment for a higher price than it originally paid. Capital gains are either short-term or long-term, depending on whether the fund holds the securities for one year or less (short-term gains) or more than one year (long-term gains).

FUNDamentalsTM

Distributions

Mutual funds make payments of fund earnings to shareholders, distributing them among all shareholders of the fund. As a shareholder, you are entitled to your portion of a fund’s distributed income, including capital gains.

Reinvesting your distributions buys you more shares of a fund – which lets you take advantage of the potential for compound growth. Putting the money you earn back into your investment means it, in turn, may earn even more money. Over time, the power of compounding has the potential to significantly increase the value of your investment. There is no assurance, however, that you’ll earn more money if you reinvest your distributions rather than receive them in cash.

The Fund intends to pay out, in the form of distributions to shareholders, a sufficient amount of its income and gains so that the Fund will qualify for treatment as a regulated investment company and generally will not have to pay any federal excise tax. The Fund generally intends to distribute any net realized capital gain (whether long-term or short-term gain) at least once a year.

Different share classes of the Fund usually pay different net investment income distribution amounts, because each class has different expenses. Each time a distribution is made, the net asset value per share of the share class is reduced by the amount of the distribution.

The Fund generally pays cash distributions within five business days after the distribution was declared (or, if the Fund declares distributions daily, within five business days after the end of the month in which the distribution was declared). If you sell all of your shares after the record date, but before the payment date, for a distribution, you’ll normally receive that distribution in cash within five business days after the sale was made.

The Fund will automatically reinvest distributions in additional shares of the same share class of the Fund unless you inform us you want to receive your distributions in cash (the financial selling and/or servicing agent through which you purchased shares may have different policies). You can do this by writing the Funds at the addresses and telephone numbers listed at the beginning of the section entitled Choosing a Share Class. No sales charges apply to the purchase or sale of such shares.

For accounts held directly with the Fund, distributions of $10 or less will automatically be reinvested in additional Fund shares only. If you elect to receive distributions by check and the check is returned as undeliverable, all subsequent distributions will be reinvested in additional shares of the Fund.

Unless you are a tax-exempt investor or holding Fund shares through a tax-advantaged account (such as a 401(k) plan or IRA), you should consider avoiding buying Fund shares shortly before the Fund makes a distribution (other than distributions of net investment income that are declared daily) of net investment income or net realized capital gain, because doing so can cost you money in taxes. This is because you will, in effect, receive part of your purchase price back in the distribution. This is known as “buying a dividend.” To avoid “buying a dividend,” before you invest, check the Fund’s distribution schedule, which is available at the Funds’ websites and/or by calling the Funds’ telephone numbers listed at the beginning of the section entitled Choosing a Share Class.

 

C-40


Table of Contents

 

If you buy shares of the Fund when it holds securities with unrealized capital gain, you may, in effect, receive part of your purchase price back if and when the Fund sells those securities and distributes any net realized gain. Any such distribution is generally subject to tax. The Fund may have, or may build up over time, high levels of unrealized capital gain. If you buy shares of the Fund when it has capital loss carryforwards, the Fund may have the ability to offset capital gains realized by the Fund that otherwise would have been distributed to shareholders with such carryforwards, although capital loss carryforwards generally expire after eight taxable years and may be subject to substantial limitations.

Taxes and Your Investment

The Fund will send you a statement each year showing how much you’ve received in distributions in the prior year and the distributions’ character for U.S. federal income tax purposes. In addition, you should be aware of the following considerations applicable to all Funds (unless otherwise noted):

 

 

The Fund intends to qualify each year as a regulated investment company. A regulated investment company generally is not subject to tax at the fund level on income and gains from investments that are distributed to shareholders. However, the Fund’s failure to qualify as a regulated investment company would result in Fund level taxation, and consequently, a reduction in income available for distribution to you. In addition, any dividends of net tax-exempt income would no longer be exempt from U.S. federal income tax and, instead, in general, would be taxable to you as ordinary income.

 

 

Distributions generally are taxable to you when paid, whether they are paid in cash or automatically reinvested in additional shares of the Fund.

 

 

Certain derivative instruments when held in a Fund’s portfolio subject the Fund to special tax rules, the effect of which may be to accelerate income to the Fund, defer fund losses, cause adjustments in the holding periods of Fund portfolio securities, convert capital gains into ordinary income and convert short-term capital losses into long-term capital losses. These rules could therefore affect the amount, timing and/or character of distributions to shareholders. For tax-exempt Funds: Derivative instruments held by a Fund may also generate taxable income to the Fund.

 

 

Certain Funds may purchase or sell (write) options, as described further in the Merger SAI. In general, option premiums which may be received by the Fund are not immediately included in the income of the Fund. Instead, such premiums are taken into account when the option contract expires, the option is exercised by the holder, or the Fund transfers or otherwise terminates the option. If an option written by a Fund is exercised and such Fund sells or delivers the underlying security, the Fund generally will recognize capital gain or loss equal to (a) the sum of the exercise price and the option premium received by the Fund minus (b) the Fund’s basis in the security. Such gain or loss generally will be short-term or long-term depending upon the holding period of the underlying security. Gain or loss with respect to any termination of a Fund’s obligation under an option other than through the exercise of the option and the related sale or delivery of the underlying security generally will be short-term gain or loss. Thus, for example, if an option written by a Fund expires unexercised, such Fund generally will recognize short-term gain equal to the premium received.

 

 

For tax-exempt Funds: Tax-exempt Funds expect that distributions will consist primarily of exempt-interest dividends. Distributions of the Fund’s net interest income from tax-exempt securities generally are not subject to U.S. federal income tax, but may be subject to state and local income and other taxes, as well as federal and state alternative minimum tax. Similarly, distributions of interest income that is exempt from state and local income taxes of a particular state generally will be exempt from such taxes, but may be subject to other taxes, including income taxes of other states, and federal and state alternative minimum tax.

 

 

For tax-exempt Funds: The Fund may invest a portion of its assets in securities that generate income that is not exempt from federal or state income tax. Distributions by the Fund of this income generally are taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions of gains realized by the Fund, including those generated from the sale or exchange of tax-exempt securities, generally also are taxable to you. Distributions of the Fund’s net short-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions of the Fund’s net long-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as long-term capital gain. Whether capital gains are long-term or short-term is determined by how long the Fund has owned the investments that generated them, rather than how long you have owned your shares.

 

 

Distributions of the Fund’s ordinary income and net short-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions of the Fund’s net long-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as long-term capital gain. Whether capital gains are long-term or short-term is determined by how long the Fund has owned the investments that generated them, rather than how long you have owned your shares.

 

 

For taxable fixed income Funds: Taxable fixed-income Funds expect that distributions will consist primarily of ordinary income.

 

 

For taxable years beginning on or before December 31, 2010, if you are an individual and you meet certain holding period and other requirements for your Fund shares, a portion of your distributions may be treated as “qualified dividend income” taxable at lower net long-term capital gain rates. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision to taxable years beginning after December 31, 2010. Qualified dividend income is income attributable to the Fund’s dividends received from

 

C-41


Table of Contents
 

certain U.S. and foreign corporations, as long as the Fund meets certain holding period and other requirements for the stock producing such dividends. For taxable fixed income Funds and tax-exempt Funds: Taxable fixed income Funds and tax-exempt Funds do not expect a significant portion of Fund distributions to be derived from qualified dividend income.

 

 

For taxable years beginning on or before December 31, 2010, the maximum individual U.S. federal income tax rate on net long-term capital gain (and thus qualified dividend income) has been temporarily reduced to 15%. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this rate reduction to taxable years beginning after December 31, 2010.

 

 

A sale, redemption or exchange of Fund shares is a taxable event. This includes redemptions where you are paid in securities. Your sales, redemptions and exchanges of Fund shares (including those paid in securities) usually will result in a taxable capital gain or loss to you, equal to the difference between the amount you receive for your shares (or are deemed to have received in the case of exchanges) and the amount you paid (or are deemed to have paid in the case of exchanges) for them. Any such capital gain or loss generally will be long-term capital gain or loss if you have held your Fund shares for more than one year at the time of sale or exchange. In certain circumstances, capital losses may be converted from short-term to long-term or disallowed.

 

 

The Fund is required by federal law to withhold tax on any taxable and possibly tax-exempt distributions and redemption proceeds paid to you (including amounts paid to you in securities and amounts deemed to be paid to you upon an exchange of shares) if: you haven’t provided a correct TIN or SSN or haven’t certified to the Fund that withholding doesn’t apply; the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) has notified us that the TIN listed on your account is incorrect according to its records; or the IRS informs the Fund that you are otherwise subject to backup withholding.

 

 

Class E and Class F shareholders, under the Columbia Gift Plan, the trustee will file all federal and state income tax returns and pay all related income taxes for income and capital gains earned prior to the trust’s termination. Under the Columbia Advantage Plan, the beneficiary will be obligated to report any income and capital gains earned by the trust on his or her own tax returns and to pay any related income taxes.

 

 

Class E and Class F shareholders, you should consult with your own tax advisor about the particular tax consequences to you of making a gift and holding Fund shares through a trust, including any applicable federal or state estate or gift tax consequences.

 

 

If at the end of the taxable year more than 50% of the value of the Fund’s assets consists of securities of foreign corporations, and the Fund makes a special election, you will generally be required to include in income your share of the foreign taxes paid by the Fund. You may be able to either deduct this amount from your income or claim it as a foreign tax credit. There is no assurance that the Fund will make a special election for a taxable year, even if it is eligible to do so.

For a Fund organized as a fund-of-funds. Because most of the Fund’s investments are shares of underlying Funds, the tax treatment of the Fund’s gains, losses, and distributions may differ from the tax treatment that would apply if either the Fund invested directly in the types of securities held by the underlying Funds or the Fund shareholders invested directly in the underlying funds. As a result, you may receive taxable distributions earlier and recognize higher amounts of capital gain or ordinary income than you otherwise would.

FUNDamentalsTM

Taxes

The information provided above is only a summary of how U.S. federal income taxes may affect your investment in the Fund. It is not intended as a substitute for careful tax planning. Your investment in the Fund may have other tax implications. It does not apply to certain types of investors who may be subject to special rules, including foreign or tax-exempt investors or those holding Fund shares through a tax-advantaged account, such as a 401(k) plan or IRA. You should consult with your own tax advisor about the particular tax consequences to you of an investment in the Fund, including the effect of any foreign, state and local taxes, and the effect of possible changes in applicable tax laws.

ADDITIONAL SERVICES AND COMPENSATION

In addition to acting as the Fund’s investment manager, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (Columbia Management) and its affiliates also receive compensation for providing other services to the Funds.

Administration Services. Ameriprise Financial, Inc., 200 Ameriprise Financial Center, Minneapolis, MN 55474, provides or compensates others to provide administrative services to the Legacy RiverSource funds, which includes the Seligman and Threadneedle branded funds. These services include administrative, accounting, treasury, and other services.

Distribution and Shareholder Services. Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.), One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, provides underwriting and distribution services to the Funds.

 

C-42


Table of Contents

 

Transfer Agency Services. Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly RiverSource Service Corporation), One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, provides or compensates others to provide transfer agency services to the Funds. The Funds pay the Transfer Agent a fee that may vary by class, as set forth in the Merger SAI, and reimburses the transfer agent for its out-of-pocket expenses incurred while providing these transfer agency services to the Funds. The Transfer Agent pays a portion of these fees to selling and servicing agents that provide sub-recordkeeping and other services to Fund shareholders. The Merger SAI provides additional information about the services provided and the fee schedules for the Transfer Agent agreements.

ADDITIONAL MANAGEMENT INFORMATION

Affiliated Products. Columbia Management serves as investment manager to the Funds, including those that are structured to provide asset-allocation services to shareholders of those Funds (funds of funds) by investing in shares of other Funds (collectively referred to as underlying funds) and to discretionary managed accounts (collectively referred to as affiliated products) that invest exclusively in underlying funds. These affiliated products, individually or collectively, may own a significant percentage of the outstanding shares of the underlying funds, and Columbia Management seeks to balance potential conflicts between the affiliated products and the underlying funds in which they invest. The affiliated products investment in the underlying funds may also have the effect of creating economies of scale (including lower expense ratios) because the affiliated products may own substantial portions of the shares of underlying funds and, comparatively, a redemption of underlying fund shares by one or more affiliated products could cause the expense ratio of an underlying fund to increase as its fixed costs would be spread over a smaller asset base. Because of these large positions of the affiliated products, the underlying funds may experience relatively large purchases or redemptions. Although Columbia Management may seek to minimize the impact of these transactions, for example, by structuring them over a reasonable period of time or through other measures, underlying funds may experience increased expenses as they buy and sell securities to manage these transactions. When Columbia Management structures transactions over a reasonable period of time in order to manage the potential impact of the buy and sell decisions for the affiliated products, these affiliated products, including funds of funds, may pay more or less for shares of the underlying funds than if the transactions were executed in one transaction. In addition, substantial redemptions by the affiliated products within a short period of time could require the underlying fund to liquidate positions more rapidly than would otherwise be desirable, which may have the effect of reducing or eliminating potential gain or causing the underlying fund to realize a loss. Substantial redemptions may also adversely affect the ability of the investment manager to implement the underlying fund’s investment strategy. Columbia Management also has an economic conflict of interest in determining the allocation of the affiliated products’ assets among the underlying funds as it earns different fees from the underlying funds. Columbia Management monitors expense levels of the Funds and is committed to offering funds that are competitively priced. Columbia Management reports to the Board of each fund of funds on the steps it has taken to manage any potential conflicts. See the Merger SAI for information on the percent of the Fund owned by affiliated products.

Cash Reserves. A Fund may invest its daily cash balance in a money market fund selected by Columbia Management, including but not limited to RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund (Short-Term Cash Fund), a money market Fund established for the exclusive use of the Funds and other institutional clients of Columbia Management. While Short-Term Cash Fund does not pay an advisory fee to Columbia Management, it does incur other expenses. A Fund will invest in Short-Term Cash Fund or any other money market fund selected by Columbia Management only to the extent it is consistent with the Fund’s investment objectives and policies. Short-Term Cash Fund is not insured or guaranteed by the FDIC or any other government agency.

Fund Holdings Disclosure. The Board has adopted policies and procedures that govern the timing and circumstances of disclosure to shareholders and third parties of information regarding the securities owned by a Fund. A description of these policies and procedures is included in the Merger SAI.

The website references herein are intended to be inactive textual references and information contained in or otherwise accessible through the referenced websites does not form a part of this combined proxy statement/prospectus.

 

C-43


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit D

Comparison of Organizational Documents

This chart highlights material differences between the terms of the Declarations of Trust/Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws of the Buying Funds and Selling Funds.

 

Group

A:

   Buying Fund: Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund.

Group

B:

   Selling Funds: Seligman Capital Fund, Seligman Growth Fund.

Group

C:

   Buying Funds: Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I.

Group

D:

   Selling Funds: RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund.

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

Shareholder Liability  

Shareholders of the Trust are protected from liability under Delaware statutory law, which provides that shareholders of a Delaware statutory trust have the same limitation of personal liability as is extended to shareholders of a private corporation for profit incorporated in the State of Delaware.

 

In addition, any shareholder or former shareholder exposed to liability by reason of a claim or demand relating solely to his or her being or having been a shareholder of the Trust, and not because of his acts or omissions, the shareholder or former shareholder (or his or her heirs, executors, administrators, or other legal representatives or in the case of a corporation or other entity, its corporate or other general successor) will be entitled to be held harmless from and indemnified out of the assets of the Trust against all loss and expense arising from such claim or demand.

  Under the Maryland General Corporation Law ("MGCL"), a stockholder of a corporation is not obligated to the corporation or its creditors with respect to the stock, except to the extent that the subscription price or other agreed upon price for the stock has not been paid or liability is otherwise imposed under the MGCL.   The shareholders of a Massachusetts business trust could, under certain circumstances, be held personally liable as partners for its obligations. However, the Declaration of Trust contains express disclaimers of shareholder liability for acts, obligations or affairs of the Trust. The Declaration of Trust also provides for indemnification and reimbursement of expenses out of the assets of a series for any shareholder held personally liable for obligations of such series. Therefore, the possibility that a shareholder could be held liable would be limited to a situation in which the assets of the applicable series had been exhausted.   Under Minnesota law, a shareholder’s liability to the corporation or its creditors is limited to paying the amount agreed to be paid for the shares which the shareholder holds or has agreed to purchase.

 

D-1


Table of Contents

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

Shareholder
Voting Rights
 

Shareholders have only the powers to vote on matters as the Trustees may consider desirable and so authorize, and those voting powers expressly granted under the 1940 Act or under the law of Delaware applicable to statutory trusts.

 

Shares may be voted in person or by proxy or in any manner authorized by the Trustees. On any matter that requires shareholder approval under the 1940 Act, whether shareholders are required to vote by series or class is determined by reference to the 1940 Act. On all other matters, all shares are voted in the aggregate and not by series or class unless the Trustees determine otherwise.

 

Each whole share is entitled to one vote as to any matter on which it is entitled to vote, and each fractional share is entitle to a proportionate fractional vote.

 

There is no cumulative voting in the election of Trustees.

 

On each matter submitted to vote of the stockholders, each holder of a share of any series or class issued by the corporation (“Common Stock”) is entitled to one vote for each share standing held irrespective of the series of Common Stock (“Series”) and all shares of all Series will vote as a single class (“Single Class Voting”); except, that (a) as to any matter requiring a separate vote of any Series by the 1940 Act or would be required under the MGCL, the requirements as to a separate vote by that Series apply in lieu of Single Class Voting as described above; (b) in the event that the separate vote requirements referred to in (a) above apply with respect to one or more Series, then, subject to (c) below, the shares of all other Series will vote as a single class; and (c) as to any matter which does not affect the interest of a particular Series, only the holders of shares of the one or more affected Series will be entitled to vote.

 

When a quorum is present at any meeting, the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes cast, or, with respect to any matter requiring a class vote, the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes cast of each class entitled

 

At all meetings of shareholders, each shareholder of record is entitled to one vote for each dollar of net asset value (number of shares owned times net asset value per share) and each fractional dollar amount is entitled to a proportionate fractional vote.

 

The shareholders have the power to vote (i) for the election of Trustees, (ii) to the same extent as shareholders of a Massachusetts business corporation as to whether or not a court action, proceeding or claim should or should not be brought or maintained derivatively or as a class action on behalf of the Trust or shareholder, (iii) with respect to termination of the Trust or any class or series of the trust, (iv) with respect to the approval or termination in accordance with the 1940 Act of any contract with any one or more corporations, trusts, associations, partnerships, limited partnerships or other types of organizations, or individuals as to which shareholder approval is required by the 1940 Act, and (v) with respect to additional matters relating to the Trust as may be required by the 1940 Act, the Declaration of Trust, the By-Laws or any registration of the Trust

 

At all meetings of the shareholders, each shareholder of record entitled to vote is entitled to one vote for each dollar of net asset value (number of shares owned times net asset value per share) and each fractional dollar amount is entitled to a proportionate fractional vote.

 

Shareholders have the power to vote (i) for the election of Directors; (ii) on most amendments to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation and on certain amendments to the corporation’s By-Laws; (iii) on certain proposed mergers and exchanges to which the corporation is a party; (iv) on the proposed sale of all or substantially all of the corporation’s property and assets not in the usual and regular course of its business; and (v) on the proposed dissolution of the corporation.

 

At all elections of Directors, each shareholder is entitled to as many votes equal to the number of dollars of net asset value of shares owned multiplied by the number of Directors to be elected and may cast all of such votes for a single Director or may distribute them among the number to be voted for, or any two or more of them.

 

D-2


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

   

to vote as a class on the matter, will decide any matter properly brought before such meeting (except that Directors may be elected by the affirmative vote of a plurality of the votes cast), unless a different vote is required under the 1940 Act or other applicable statutes or regulations or the Articles of Incorporation. Each share may be voted for as many individuals as there are Directors to be elected and for whose election the share is entitled to be voted.

 

As to any matter with respect to which a separate vote of any class is required by the 1940 Act or by MGCL, such requirement as to a separate vote by the class applies in lieu of Single Class Voting, and, if permitted by the 1940 Act or any rules, regulations or orders thereunder or under the MGCL, all classes of a particular Series vote together as a single class on any matter that has the same effect on each class of that Series. As to any matter that does not affect the interest of a particular class, only the holders of shares of the affected class are entitled to vote.

 

with the SEC (or any successor agency) or any State, or as the Trustees may consider necessary or desirable.

 

On any matter submitted to a vote of shareholders, all shares entitled to vote will be voted in the aggregate as a single class without regard to series or class of shares, except that shares may be voted by individual series or classes (1) when required by the 1940 Act, (2) when the Trustees have determined that the matter affects one or more series or classes of shares materially differently, or (3) when the matter affects only the interests of one or more series or classes.

 

There is no cumulative voting in the election of Trustees.

  The standard form of certifying resolution creating rights and preferences for series of capital stock provides that each share may be voted by series (i) as required by the provisions of the 1940 Act and all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder; (ii) when the Board of Directors determines that a matter affects series in a materially different way; or (iii) when the Board of Directors determines a matter affects only one or some of the series. In addition, under Minnesota law, shareholders are entitled to vote as separate series or classes with respect to certain amendments to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation and on certain mergers and exchanges to which the corporation is a party.
Shareholder Meetings  

The Trust is not required to hold annual meetings of shareholders.

 

Shareholders have the right to call special meetings and vote to remove Trustees but only if and to the extent the SEC staff takes the

  Regular stockholder meetings are not required, unless stockholders are required to meet for the purposes of electing Directors pursuant to the 1940 Act.   The Declaration of Trust and By-Laws do not address annual shareholder meetings. Regular shareholder meetings are not required for business trusts under the General Laws of Massachusetts.   Regular shareholder meetings are not required; however, a majority of Directors present at a duly held meeting may call a regular meeting of shareholders by fixing the date, time and place for a meeting.

 

D-3


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

  

Group D

   position by rule, interpretive letter or public release that Section 16(c) of the 1940 Act gives them such right. Otherwise, only the Trustees, the chairman of the Trustees or the president of the Trust may call shareholder meetings.   

The chairman of the Board of Directors, president, chief executive officer or Board of Directors may call a special meeting of the stockholders.

 

In addition, a special meeting of stockholders shall be called by the secretary of the corporation on the written request of stockholders holding at least a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote. The stockholders must send written notice to the secretary and other procedural requirements must be met.

 

Any special meeting to be held pursuant to stockholders’ request may not be held more than 90 days after the record date for the meeting.

   Shareholder meetings will be held when called by the Trustees for the purpose of taking action on any matter requiring the vote or authority of the shareholders, or for any other matter the Trustees deem necessary or desirable.   

If a regular meeting of shareholders has not been held during the immediately preceding 15 months, a shareholder or shareholders holding three percent or more of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote may demand a regular meeting of shareholders by written notice of demand given to the chief executive officer or chief financial officer. Within 30 days after receipt of the demand by one of those officers, the Board of Directors must cause a regular meeting of shareholders to be called and held on notice no later than 90 days after receipt of the demand, all at the expense of the Fund.

 

Special meetings of the shareholders may be called at any time as provided for by the laws of the State of Minnesota.

 

In addition, a special meeting of shareholders may be called at any time by a shareholder or shareholders holding 10% or more of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote, except that a special meeting for the purpose of considering any action to directly or indirectly facilitate or effect a business combination must be called by 25% or more of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote.

 

D-4


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

  

Group D

Shareholder Quorum

  

Except when a larger quorum is required by applicable law, thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of the shares entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at a shareholders’ meeting. When any one or more series or classes of the Trust is to vote as a single class separate from any other shares, thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of the shares of each such series or classes entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at a shareholder’s meeting of that series.

 

A meeting may be adjourned, whether or not a quorum is present, by the vote of a majority of the shares represented at the meeting, either in person or by proxy. If a meeting is adjourned, notice does not need to be given of the adjourned meeting date unless a new record date for the adjourned meeting is set or unless the adjourned meeting is to take place more than sixty (60) days from the date set for the original meeting, in which case the Board of Trustees would be required to set a new record date.

  

The presence in person or by proxy of the holders of record of one-third of the shares of all Series and classes issued and outstanding and entitled to vote at a meeting constitute a quorum except as otherwise provided by law or the Articles of Incorporation. Where the holders of shares of any Series or class are entitled to vote separately as a class, the presence in person or by proxy of the holders of one-third of the shares of that separate class issued and outstanding and entitled to vote at the meeting constitutes a quorum for that vote.

 

If a quorum is not present or represented at the meeting, the holders of a majority of the shares present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote have the power to adjourn the meeting without notice other than announcement at the meeting, until a quorum is present. If, however, such quorum is not present at any meeting of the stockholders, the stockholders or the chairman of the meeting shall have the power to adjourn the meeting from time to time to a date not more than 120 days after the original record date without notice other than announcement at the meeting. At any adjourned meeting at which a quorum may be present, any business may be transacted which might have been transacted at the meeting as originally called.

  

The presence in person or by proxy of 30% of the votes entitled to be cast at a meeting constitutes a quorum.

 

When any one or more series or classes votes as a single class separate from any other shares which are to vote on the same matters as a separate class or classes, 30% of the votes entitled to be cast by each such class entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at a shareholders’ meeting of that class.

 

A meeting may be adjourned by a majority of the votes properly cast upon the question, whether or not a quorum is present, and the meeting may be held as adjourned within a reasonable time after the date set for the original meeting without further notice.

   The holders of at least 10% of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote, present in person or by proxy, constitute a quorum, but the holders of a smaller amount may adjourn without further notice, other than by notice at the time, until a quorum is secured at any such adjourned meeting. In case a quorum is not present, the meeting may be adjourned without notice other than by notice at the meeting. At any adjourned meeting at which a quorum may be present, any business may be transacted which might have been transacted at the meeting as originally called.

 

D-5


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

    The stockholders present either in person or by proxy, at a meeting which has been duly called and convened, may continue to transact business until adjournment, notwithstanding the withdrawal of enough stockholders to leave less than a quorum    
Shareholder Consent   Any action taken by shareholders may be taken without a meeting if shareholders holding a majority of the shares entitled to vote on the matter and holding a majority of the shares of any series or class entitled to vote separately on the matter consent to the action in writing and such written consents are filed with the records of the meetings of shareholders. Such consent is treated for all purposes as a vote taken at a meeting of shareholders.   Any action required or permitted of stockholders must be taken at a meeting.   Except as otherwise provided by law, the Declaration of Trust or the By-Laws, any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of shareholders may be taken without a meeting if a majority of the shareholders entitled to vote consent to the action in writing and the consents are filed with the records of the Trust. The consent will be treated for all purposes as a vote taken at a meeting of shareholders.   An action required or permitted to be taken at a shareholder meeting may be taken by written action signed, or consented to by authorized electronic communication, by all of the shareholders entitled to vote on that action. Such a written action is not effective if it is signed or consented to by fewer than all the shareholders entitled to vote on the action.
Notice to Shareholders of Record Date  

Notice of any meeting of shareholders must be given by the Trustees, chairman of the Trustees or president not less than 7 days nor more than 120 days before the date of the meeting.

 

The Trustees may set a record date for the purpose of determining the shareholders entitled to vote or act at a shareholders’ meeting. The record date cannot be more than 120 days before the date of the meeting.

 

In general, stockholders entitled to vote at or receive notice of a stockholder meeting must be given written notice of at least 10 days and not more than 90 days before the meeting. Unless otherwise required by statute, any business may be conducted at the annual meeting without being designated in the notice. No business may be transacted at a special meeting of stockholders except as specifically designated in the notice.

 

The Directors may set a record date for the purpose of determining the stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at a stockholder meeting. The record date cannot be more than 90 days or less

 

Written notice of any meeting of shareholders must be given by the Trustees at least 7 days before the meeting.

 

The Trustees may set a record date for the purpose of determining the shareholders entitled to notice of or to vote at a shareholder meeting. The record date cannot be more than 90 days or less than 7 days before the date of the meeting.

 

In general, shareholders who are entitled to vote at a shareholder meeting must be given notice of the meeting at least ten and not more than 60 days before the meeting. In certain cases, the notice of meeting must include specified information required by Minnesota law.

 

The Board of Directors can establish a record date for determining the shareholders who are entitled to vote at a shareholder meeting. The record date cannot be more than 60 days before the date of the meeting.

 

D-6


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

    than 10 days before the date of the meeting. Instead of fixing a record date, the Board of Directors may close the stock transfer books for not more than 20 days. If the stock transfer books are closed for this purpose, they must be closed for at least 10 days before the date of the meeting.    
Shareholder Proxies  

Shareholders my vote in person or by proxy.

 

Unless the Trustees declare otherwise, proxies may be given by any electronic or telecommunications device, including telefacsimile, telephone or through the Internet, but if a proposal by anyone other than the officers or Trustees is submitted to a vote of the shareholders of any series or class, or if there is a proxy contest or proxy solicitation or proposal in opposition to any proposal by the officers or Trustees, shares may be voted only in person or by written proxy unless the Trustees specifically authorize other permissible methods of transmission.

 

The Trustees may appoint inspectors for any meeting of shareholders, and these inspectors are charged with, among other things, determining the authenticity, validity and effect of proxies

 

A stockholder may cast his or her votes in person or by proxy executed by the stockholder or by the stockholder’s duly authorized agent in any manner permitted or not prohibited by law.

 

The proxy or evidence of authorization of the proxy must be filed with the secretary of the corporation before or at the meeting. No proxy is valid more than eleven months after its date unless otherwise provided in the proxy.

 

Shareholders may vote in person or by proxy.

 

A proxy with respect to shares held in the name of two or more persons will be valid if executed by any one of them unless at or prior to exercise of the proxy the Trust receives a specific written notice to the contrary from any one of them. A proxy purporting to be executed by or on behalf of a shareholder will be deemed valid unless challenged at or prior to its exercise and the burden of proving invalidity rests on the challenger.

 

At each shareholder meeting, the polls may be opened and closed, the proxies and ballots may be received and taken in charge, and all questions touching the qualification of voters, the validity of proxies, and acceptances or rejections of votes may be decided by two (2) inspectors of election.

 

Minnesota law provides that shareholders can submit proxies in writing or by telephonic transmission or authenticated electronic communication. It also provides that the Board of Directors can establish procedures whereby a record holder can certify in writing that another person is the beneficial owner of shares, and the beneficial owner then can vote the shares or appoint a proxy.

 

D-7


Table of Contents

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

Director/Trustee Power to Amend Organizational Document   The Trustees may, without shareholder vote, amend or otherwise supplement the Declaration of Trust; provided that shareholders have the right to vote on any amendment if expressly required under Delaware law or the 1940 Act, or submitted to shareholders by the Trustees at their discretion.   The corporation may amend the Articles of Incorporation if a majority of all the outstanding shares of all classes or the affected class or classes entitled to vote, vote in favor of the amendment, or consent in writing to such amendment.  

The Trustees may amend the Declaration of Trust at any time by an instrument in writing signed by a majority of the then Trustees provided that notice of such amendment is transmitted promptly to shareholders of record.

 

The Trustees need not, however, provide notice of an amendment if the amendment is for the purpose of supplying an omission, curing any ambiguity or curing, correcting or supplementing any defective or inconsistent provision contained in the Declaration of Trust, or having any other purpose which is ministerial or clerical in nature.

  The Articles of Incorporation may be amended, altered, changed or repealed in a manner prescribed by the laws of the State of Minnesota.
Termination of Corporation/Trust   The Trust and any series thereof may be terminated at any time by the Board of Trustees with written notice to shareholders. To the extent the 1940 Act expressly allows shareholders the power to vote on such terminations, the Trust or any series thereof may be terminated by a vote of a majority of shares entitled to vote.    

The Trust may be terminated by the Trustees with written notice to shareholders, or by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the shares of each series entitled to vote.

 

Any series of or class may be terminated by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the shares of that series or class, or by the Trustees by written notice to the shareholders of that series or class.

  In order to dissolve a Minnesota corporation, the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote is required. In order to discontinue an individual class or series of shares without dissolving the corporation, an amendment to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation is required. In order to adopt such an amendment, shareholders must approve the amendment by the affirmative vote of the greater of (i) a majority of the voting power of the shares of that class or series present and entitled to vote or (ii) a majority of the voting power of the minimum number of shares of such class or series entitled to vote that would constitute a quorum for the transaction of business at the meeting (a “Minnesota Statutory Vote”).

 

D-8


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

         The Board of Directors, acting without a shareholder vote, does not have the power to dissolve the corporation or to discontinue an individual class or series of shares.
Merger or Consolidation    The Trustees have the power to cause the Trust or any series to be merged or consolidated with another trust or company. The Trustees may accomplish such merger or consolidation with written notice to shareholders but without the vote of shareholders, unless such shareholder vote is required by law.   The corporation has the right to take any lawful action to make any amendment to the Articles of Incorporation, including the right to make any amendment authorizing any sale, lease, exchange or transfer of the property and assets of the Corporation, if a majority of all the shares of all series and classes affected by such action and outstanding and entitled to vote, vote in favor of such action or amendment, or consent thereto in writing.   Subject to applicable laws, the Trustees may, without shareholder consent, cause the Trust or any series to be merged or consolidated with another trust or company. The Trustees may also transfer all or a substantial portion of the Trust’s assets to another fund or company.  

In most cases, any merger or exchange in which a Minnesota corporation is not the continuing entity, and any sale of all or substantially all of the corporation’s property and assets not in the usual and regular course of its business, requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote.

 

Any sale of the assets belonging to an individual series of shares of a Minnesota corporation in exchange for shares of another corporation or trust or shares of another series of the corporation, while leaving other series of the corporation outstanding, would require an amendment to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation. In order to adopt such an amendment, shareholders of that series would have to approve the amendment by a Minnesota Statutory Vote.

Removal of Directors/
Trustees
   A Trustee may be removed with or without cause at any time by a written instrument signed by at least two-thirds of the other Trustees.     Trustees may be removed with or without cause by majority vote of the Trustees.   Under Minnesota law, the Board of Directors can remove a Director by a majority vote of the remaining Directors, but only if the Director was appointed by the Board of Directors to fill a vacancy and has not subsequently been elected by shareholders.

 

D-9


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

  In addition, if required by Section 16(c) of the 1940 Act, any Trustee may be removed at any meeting of the shareholders by a vote of at least two-thirds of the outstanding shares.       In all other cases, a Director can only be removed by shareholder vote. In general, such removal requires the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote at an election of Directors. However, where a corporation has cumulative voting (as do the Funds), unless the entire Board of Directors is removed simultaneously, a Director is not removed from the Board of Directors if there are cast against removal of the Director the votes of a proportion of the voting power sufficient to elect the Director at an election of the entire Board of Directors under cumulative voting.
Director/Trustee Committees  

The Trust has two standing committees that may not be abolished: the Audit Committee and the Nominating Committee. Otherwise, the Trustees may, with a majority vote of the Trustees, appoint from their number other committees consisting of two or more Trustees which may be delegated such authority as the Trustees consider desirable. The Trustees may also abolish the non-standing committees with a majority vote of the Trustees.

 

Each committee may elect a chair and each committee must maintain records of its meetings and report its actions to the full Board of Trustees.

 

The Board of Directors may appoint from among its members an Executive Committee, an Audit Committee, a Board Operations Committee, a Nominating Committee and other committees, composed of one or more Directors, to serve at the pleasure of the Board of Directors. Any director may give notice to the Board of Directors at any time of his or her resignation from any committee on which he or she serves.

 

The Board of Directors may delegate to committees appointed pursuant to the Articles of Incorporation any of the powers of the Board of Directors, except as prohibited by law.

  The Trustees may appoint from their own number and terminate committees consisting of one or more Trustees, which may exercise the powers and authority of the Trustees to the extent that the Trustees determine.   The corporation’s By-Laws provide that the Board of Directors may, by resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board of Directors, designate an Executive Committee of two or more Directors, which may meet at stated times or on notice to all by any of their number during intervals between meetings of the Board of Directors. The Executive Committee will advise with and aid the officers of the Fund in all matters concerning its interests and the management of its business, and generally perform such duties and exercise such powers as may be delegated to it from time to time by the Board of Directors.

 

D-10


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

  A majority of the authorized number of committee members shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business of such committee, unless the Board of Trustees designates a lower percentage.  

Any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of a committee of the Board of Directors may be taken without a meeting, if a consent to such action in writing or by electronic transmission is given by each member of the committee and filed with the minutes of proceedings of such committee.

 

Subject to the previous sections, the Board of Directors has the power at any time to change the membership of any committee, to fill all vacancies, to designate alternate members to replace any absent or disqualified member or to dissolve any such committee. Subject to the power of the Board of Directors, the members of a committee have the power to fill any vacancies on such committee.

    The Board of Directors also may, by resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board of Directors, appoint any other committee or committees for any purpose or purposes, which committee or committees will have such powers as specified in the resolution of appointment. The quorum for such committee established by the Board of Directors is two members regardless of the number of members serving on the committee.
Director/Trustee Liability   Trustees will be liable to the Trust by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of the Trustee’s office.   A Director or officer of the corporation will not be liable to the corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a Director or officer, except to the extent such exemption from liability or limitation thereof is not permitted by law (including the 1940 Act).   Trustees are not subject to personal liability, except by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of the office of Trustee. Additionally, Trustees are not personally liable for any neglect or wrong-doing of any officer, agent, or employee of the Trust or for any act or omission of any other Trustee.   To the full extent permitted by the laws of the State of Minnesota, no Director of the Fund will be liable to the Fund or to its shareholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a Director but such limit on liability will be permitted only to the extent allowable under the provisions of the 1940 Act.

 

D-11


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

    Directors and officers will not be protected from liability to the corporation or stockholders for willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of his or her office.   Trustees that are singled out as experts on particular issues, such as a chair of a committee, are not held to any higher standard than their non-expert counterparts.   Under Minnesota law, the foregoing provision is not effective to eliminate a Director’s personal liability to the Funds or its shareholders for, among other things, (i) any breach of the Director’s duty of loyalty to the corporation or its shareholders; (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or that involve intentional misconduct or knowing violation of law; or (iii) any transaction from which the Director derived an improper personal benefit.
Director/Trustee Indemnification  

The Trust indemnifies the Trustees against expenses, judgments, fines and settlements and other amounts actually and reasonably incurred in connection with any civil or criminal proceeding or investigations, if it is determined that the Trustee acted in good faith and reasonably believed 1) that his or her conduct was in the Trust’s best interests, and 2) that his or her conduct was at least not opposed to the Trust’s best interests, and 3) in the case of a criminal proceeding, that he or she had no reasonable cause to believe that the conduct was unlawful.

 

A Trustee will not, however, be indemnified 1) with respect to any matters where the Trustee is judged to be liable on the basis that a personal benefit was improperly received, whether or not the benefit resulted from action taken in that Trustee’s official capacity, 2) with respect to any matter where the

  The corporation will indemnify to the fullest extent permitted by law any person made or threatened to be made a party to any action, suit or proceeding, whether criminal, civil, administrative or investigative, by reason of the fact that such person is or was a Director, officer or employee of the corporation or serves or served at the request of the corporation any other enterprise as a Director, officer or employee. To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses incurred by any such person in defending any such action, suit or proceeding will be paid or reimbursed by the corporation promptly, provided that such person agrees to repay such expenses if it is ultimately determined that such person is not entitled to be indemnified by the corporation. The Articles of Incorporation may not be amended to adversely affect this protection. These provisions do not waive compliance with  

The Trust indemnifies each of its Trustees against all liabilities and expenses, including amounts paid in satisfaction of judgments, in compromise or as fines and penalties, and attorneys’ fees incurred in connection with the defense of any civil or criminal suit or action, except with respect to any matter (i) as to which a Trustee is finally adjudicated in any such action or proceeding not to have acted in good faith in reasonable belief that such Trustee’s action was in the best interests of the Trust; or (ii) where the Trustee acted in willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of such Trustee’s office.

 

Expenses, including counsel fees, so incurred by any such Trustee (but excluding amounts paid in satisfaction of judgments, in compromise or as fines or penalties) will be paid from time to time by the

  Each person made or threatened to be made a party to or is involved (including, without limitation, as a witness) in any actual or threatened action, suit or proceeding whether civil, criminal, administrative, arbitration, or investigative, including a proceeding by or in the right of the Fund by reason of the former or present capacity as a Director of the Fund or who, while a Director of the Fund, is or was serving at the request of the Fund or whose duties as a Director involve or involved service as a director, officer, partner, trustee or agent of another organization or employee benefit plan, whether the basis of any proceeding is alleged action in an official capacity or in any capacity while serving as a director, officer, partner, trustee or agent, will be indemnified and held harmless by the Fund to the full extent authorized by the Minnesota Business Corporation Act, as the same or may hereafter be

 

D-12


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

 

Trustee is judged to be liable in the performance of his or her duty to the Trust unless the adjudicator determines that the Trustee was not liable as the result of conduct in (1) above and that the Trustee is fairly entitled to indemnification, and 3) with respect to amounts paid to settle or dispose of an action with or without court approval unless a) approved by a majority vote of a quorum of Trustees who are not parties and are disinterested persons, or b) a written opinion of counsel is obtained.

 

Expenses incurred in defending any proceeding may be advanced by the Trust before the final disposition of a proceeding upon a written undertaking by the Trustee to repay the amount advanced if it is ultimately determined that he or she is not entitled to indemnification, together with at least on of the following conditions to the advance: 1) security for the undertaking, 2) the existence of insurance protecting the Trust against losses arising by reason of any lawful advances, or 3) a determination by a majority of a quorum of the Trustees who are not parties to the proceeding and are not interested persons of the Trust, or by an independent legal counsel, based on a review of the readily available facts that there

  the Securities Act of 1933 or the 1940 Act or other valid rule, regulation or order of the SEC.   Trust in advance of the final disposition of any such action, suit or proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such Trustee to repay amounts so paid to the Trust if it is ultimately determined that indemnification of such expenses is not authorized under the By-Laws, provided, however, that either (a) such Trustee shall have provided appropriate security for such undertaking, (b) the Trust shall be insured against losses arising from any such advance payments, or (c) either a majority of the disinterested Trustees acting on the matter (provided that a majority of the disinterested Trustees then in office act on the matter), or independent legal counsel in a written opinion, will have determined, based upon a review of readily available facts, that there is reason to believe that such Trustee will be found entitled to indemnification under the By-Laws.   amended (but, in the case of any such amendment, only to the extent that such amendment permits the Fund to provide broader indemnification rights than the law permitted the Fund to provide prior to such amendment, or by any other applicable law as then in effect, against judgments, penalties, fines including, without limitation, excise taxes assessed against the person with respect to an employee benefit plan, settlements and reasonable expenses, including attorneys' fees and disbursements, incurred in connection therewith and such indemnification will continue as to any person who has ceased to be a Director or officer and will inure to the benefit of the person's heirs, executors and administrators provided, however, in an action brought against the Fund to enforce rights to indemnification, the Director will be indemnified only if the action was authorized by the Board of Directors of the Fund. The right to indemnification conferred by the Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws is a contract right and includes the right to be paid by the Fund in advance of the final disposition of a proceeding for expenses incurred in connection therewith provided, however, such payment of expenses will be made only upon receipt of a

 

D-13


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

  is reason to believe that the Trustee ultimately will be found entitled to indemnification.      

written undertaking by the Director to repay all amounts so paid if it is ultimately determined that the Director is not entitled to indemnification.

 

Any indemnification under the Articles of Incorporation or the By-Laws is not exclusive of any other rights of indemnification to which the Directors might otherwise be entitled. No indemnification will be made in violation of the Investment Company Act of 1940.

Dividends   The Trustees may declare and pay dividends and distributions to shareholders of each series from the assets of such series.   Dividends and distributions on shares of a particular class may be paid to the holders of shares of that class at such times, in such manner and from such of the income and capital gains, accrued or realized, from the assets belonging to that class, after providing for actual and accrued liabilities belonging to that class, as the Board of Directors may determine.   Dividends and distributions may be paid to shareholders from the Trust’s net income with the frequency as the Trustees may determine.   The corporation’s Articles of Incorporation provide that the Directors may declare and pay dividends in their discretion at any time and from time to time to the extent and from such sources as permitted by the laws of the State of Minnesota. Under Minnesota law, the Board of Directors can authorize a dividend if it determines that the corporation will be able to pay its debts in the ordinary course of business after paying the dividend.
Capitalization   The beneficial interest in the Trust shall at all times be divided into an unlimited number of shares, without par value.  

The Board of Directors has power and authority to increase or decrease the number of shares of stock, series or class of stock, that the corporation has the authority to issue.

 

The total number of shares of capital stock of all series and classes which the corporation has authority to issue is 1,000,000,000 shares of the par value of $.001 per share, having an aggregate par value of $1,000,000.

  The beneficial interest in the Trust shall at all times be divided into an unlimited number of shares without par value.   The Corporation’s articles of incorporation authorize the issuance of up to 10,000,000,000 shares of stock with a par value of $.01 per share. The Board of Directors can authorize the issuance of shares in such classes or series with such designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights, or qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, as are stated in the Board

 

D-14


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

        resolution establishing the class or series. The Board of Directors can, without shareholder approval, increase or decrease the total number of authorized shares, or the authorized shares of a class or series, in the manner and to the extent set forth under “Directors’ Power to Amend Articles of Incorporation/Trustees’ Power to Amend Declaration of Trust” above.
Number of Directors/
Trustees and Vacancies
 

The number of Trustees may be fixed by the Trustees from time to time by a written instrument signed, or a resolution approved at a duly constituted meeting, by a majority of the Trustees. Provided, however, that the number of Trustees cannot be fewer than 1 or more than 15.

 

Vacancies in the Board of Trustees may be filled by a majority of the remaining Trustees, even if less than a quorum, or by a sole remaining Trustee, unless the Trustees call a meeting of shareholders for the purpose of electing Trustees. In the event that at any time less than a majority of the Trustees holding office at that time were so elected by shareholders, the Board of Trustees will hold a shareholders’ meeting within 60 days for the election of Trustees to fill such vacancies on the board.

 

The number of Directors will never be fewer than the greater of three and the minimum number required by the MGCL (one), nor more than 20, and the tenure of a Directorship will not be affected by any decrease in the number of Directors.

 

Any vacancy occurring in the Board of Directors for any cause other than by reason of an increase in the number of Directors may be filled by a majority of the remaining members of the Board of Directors, even if such majority is less than a quorum. Any vacancy occurring by reason of an increase in the number of Directors may be filled by a majority of the entire Board of Directors then in office. A Director elected by the Board of Directors to fill a vacancy will be elected to hold office until the next annual meeting of stockholders and until his or her successor is elected and qualifies.

 

The Trustees may fix the number of Trustees, fill vacancies in the Trustees, including vacancies arising from an increase in the number of Trustees, or remove Trustees with or without cause.

 

Shareholders may fix the number of Trustees and elect Trustees at any meeting of Shareholders called by the Trustees for that purpose and to the extent required by applicable law, including paragraphs (a) and (b) of Section 16 of the 1940 Act.

 

Each Trustee serves during the continued lifetime of the Trust until he or she dies, resigns or is removed, or, if sooner, until the next meeting of Shareholders called for the purpose of electing Trustees and until the election and qualification of his or her successor.

  There may be no fewer than two or more than 15 Directors. If a vacancy occurs in the Board of Directors by reason of death, resignation or otherwise, such vacancy may be filled for the unexpired term by a majority vote of the remaining Directors, even if the remaining number of Directors is less than a quorum.

 

D-15


Table of Contents

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

Independent Chair of the Board   The Declaration of Trust does not require an independent chair of the Board of Trustees.   The Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws do not require an independent chair of the Board of Directors.   The Declaration of Trust and By-Laws do not require an independent chair of the board of Trustees.   The Corporation’s By-Laws require the Board of Directors to elect one independent member to serve as Chair of the Board of Directors whose duties include serving as the lead independent Director.
Inspection of Books and Records   The original or a copy of the Declaration of Trust, and of each amendment thereto, is kept at the office of the Trust where it may be inspected by any shareholder.  

Under the MGCL, any stockholder or his agent may inspect and copy during usual business hours the corporation’s By-Laws, minutes of the proceedings of the stockholders, annual statements of affairs, and voting trust agreements on file at the corporation's principal office.

 

In addition, one or more persons who together are and for at least six months have been stockholders of record of at least 5 percent of the outstanding stock of any class of the corporation may, in person or by agent, on written request, inspect and copy during usual business hours the corporation's books of account and its stock ledger, present to any officer or resident agent of the corporation a written request for a statement of its affairs, and in the case of any corporation which does not maintain the original or a duplicate stock ledger at its principal office, present to any officer or resident agent of the corporation a written request for a list of its stockholders.

  The original or a copy of the Declaration of Trust, and of each amendment thereto, is kept at the office of the Trust where it may be inspected by any shareholder.   Minnesota law requires the corporation (each Fund) to keep (i) a share register containing the names and addresses of its shareholders and the number and classes of shares held by each; (ii) records of all proceedings of shareholders for the last three years; (iii) records of all proceedings of the Board of Directors for the last three years; (iv) its Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws, as amended; (v) certain financial statements which Minnesota law requires the corporation (each Fund) to prepare; (vi) all reports to shareholders generally within the last three years; and (vii) a statement of the names and usual business addresses of its Directors and principal officers. The Fund’s shareholders and beneficial owners have the right, upon written demand stating the purpose, at any reasonable time to examine and copy those records which are reasonably related to the stated purpose, provided that the stated purpose is reasonably related to the person’s interest as a shareholder or beneficial owner.

 

D-16


Table of Contents

 

Policy

 

Group A

 

Group B

 

Group C

 

Group D

    The corporation’s By-Laws provides that a stockholder with the right, under applicable law, to inspect the corporation’s books of account, stock ledger, or other specified documents of the corporation has no right to make an inspection if the Board of Directors determines that the stockholder has an improper purpose for requesting the inspection.    
Involuntary Redemption of Accounts   The Trustees may redeem, repurchase and transfer shares pursuant to applicable law.  

The Board of Directors may, from time to time in its discretion, authorize the Corporation to require the redemption of all or any part of the outstanding shares of any series or class for the proportionate interest per share in the assets of the corporation belonging to that series or class, or the cash equivalent thereof (being the net asset value per share determined as provided in the Articles of Incorporation), upon the sending of written notice thereof to each stockholder any of whose shares are so redeemed and upon such terms and conditions as the Board of Directors deem advisable.

The Board of Directors may also authorize the officers of the Corporation to repurchase shares of any series or class, either directly or through an agent. The price to be paid by the corporation upon any such repurchase to be determined, in the discretion of the Board of Directors, in accordance with applicable law.

  The Trust has the right at its option and at any time to redeem shares of any shareholder at the net asset value thereof: (i) if at such time such shareholder owns shares of any series or class having an aggregate net asset value of less than an amount determined from time to time by the Trustees; or (ii) to the extent that such shareholder owns shares equal to or in excess of a percentage determined from time to time by the Trustees of the outstanding shares of the Trust or of any series or class.   The Fund may redeem the shares of a shareholder if the amount invested is less than an amount determined by the Board of Directors and set forth in the current Fund prospectus.

 

D-17


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit E

Share Ownership of Nominees

As of [•], the Nominees and officers of the Companies, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of each class of shares of each Fund. The table below shows, for each Nominee, the amount of shares of each Fund beneficially owned by the Nominee. It also shows the aggregate value of all investments in shares of the Combined Funds Complex overseen or to be overseen by the Nominees, including notional amounts through the Deferred Compensation Agreement. Ownership information is presented in the following ranges: A = $0; B = $1-$10,000; C = $10,001-$50,000; D = $50,001-$100,000; and E = over $100,000.

Independent Nominee Ownership as of September 30, 2010

 

Fund

  

Kathleen
Blatz

  

Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.

  

Pamela G.
Carlton

  

William P.
Carmichael

  

Patricia M.
Flynn

  

William A.
Hawkins

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund    A    N/A    A    N/A    A    N/A
Seligman Capital Fund    A    N/A    A    N/A    A    N/A
RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund    A    N/A    A    N/A    A    N/A
Seligman Growth Fund    A    N/A    A    N/A    C*    N/A
RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund    A    N/A    A    N/A    A    N/A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee

   E    N/A    E**    N/A    E**    N/A

 

* Deferred compensation invested in share equivalents: Seligman Growth Fund: $10,001-$50,000
** Total includes deferred compensation invested in share equivalents

 

Fund

  

R. Glenn
Hilliard

  

Stephen R.
Lewis, Jr.

  

John F.
Maher

  

John J.
Nagorniak

  

Catherine
James Paglia

  

Leroy C.
Richie

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund    N/A    A    A    N/A    A    A
Seligman Capital Fund    N/A    A    A    N/A    A    B
RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund    N/A    A    A    N/A    A    A
Seligman Growth Fund    N/A    A    A    N/A    A    B
RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund    N/A    A    A    N/A    A    A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee

   N/A    E**    E**    N/A    E**    E

 

** Total includes deferred compensation invested in share equivalents

 

Fund

  

Alison
Taunton-Rigby

  

Minor M.
Shaw

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund    A    N/A
Seligman Capital Fund    A    N/A
RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund    A    N/A
Seligman Growth Fund    D    N/A
RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund    A    N/A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee

   E    N/A

 

E-1


Table of Contents

 

Interested Nominee Ownership as of September 30, 2010

 

Fund

   William F.
Truscott
   Anthony M.
Santomero
RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund    A    N/A
Seligman Capital Fund    A    N/A
RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund    A    N/A
Seligman Growth Fund    E    N/A
RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund    C    N/A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee

   E    N/A

 

E-2


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit F

RIVERSOURCE FUNDS BOARD

Board Governance Committee Charter

Introduction

The Board of Directors/Trustees of each RiverSource Fund (the “Board”) is responsible for protecting the interests of each RiverSource Fund (each, a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”) and its shareholders. In this connection, the Board has established a Board Governance Committee (the “Committee”). The Board has adopted this Board Governance Committee Charter (the “Charter”) for purposes of delineating the scope of the Committee’s authority and responsibility, and defining key attributes of the Committee and its members.

Committee Purpose

The mission of the Committee under this Charter is to review and oversee Fund governance matters, including protecting and furthering the interest of the Funds and their shareholders on external matters.

Committee Authority and Responsibilities

To carry out its purpose, the Committee shall have the following powers and duties:

 

   

Governance Matters

  o Make recommendations to the Board on:
   

The responsibilities and duties of the Board;

   

The criteria to be used to determine the size and structure of the Board, and the background and characteristics of Independent Directors/Trustees of the Board (the “Independent Directors”);

   

The persons to serve as Board members based on approved criteria whenever necessary to fill a vacancy or in conjunction with a regular meeting of shareholders in which nominees are required to be submitted for a vote of shareholders;

   

The process for conducting the annual evaluation of the Board’s performance;

   

The nomination of the Board Chair, the members to serve on each committee of the Board, and the member who should serve as Chair of each committee; and

   

The compensation to be paid to the Independent Directors.

  o Have one or more of its members meet personally with each candidate for Board membership to evaluate the candidate’s ability to work effectively with other members of the Board, while also exercising independent judgment.
  o Consider the individual professional and personal backgrounds of each Board candidate or nominee and assess how those would fit into the mix of experiences represented by the then-current Board.
  o Oversee the proxy voting policies and procedures with respect to voting proxies relating to portfolio securities.
  o Assist the Board Chair in furthering the interests of the Funds and their shareholders with respect to matters involving regulatory, governmental and investor organizations.

 

   

Reporting to Board

  o The Committee shall report quarterly to the Board, or more frequently as appropriate, on matters considered, conclusions reached, and action taken by the Committee. Recommendations to the Board or action recommended to be taken by the Board will be at the discretion of the Committee members and the Committee Chair.

The Committee shall be assigned such additional areas of responsibility as appropriate to assist the Board in meeting its fiduciary duties in an efficient and effective manner.

 

F-1


Table of Contents

 

The members of the Committee shall serve as the directors of Board Services Corporation (“BSC”) as provided by the Operating Guidelines of BSC.

Committee Operations

The agenda for each Committee meeting shall be prepared under the direction and control of the Chair.

The Committee shall ordinarily meet in person; however, members may attend telephonically, and the Committee may act by written consent, to the extent permitted by law and by the Funds’ bylaws.

The Committee shall have the authority to meet privately and to admit non-members individually.

The Committee shall prepare and retain minutes of its meetings and appropriate documentation of decisions made outside of meetings by delegated authority.

The Committee shall evaluate its performance at least annually.

Committee Membership

The Committee shall be comprised exclusively of Independent Directors. Each member of the Committee, including the Chair, will be appointed by the vote of a majority of the Independent Directors then serving on the Board. Members of the Committee will serve at the pleasure of the Independent Directors on the Board.

Meetings

The Committee meets on the dates established on an annual agenda. The Committee may hold additional meetings as called by the Committee Chair, the Board Chair, or any two members of the Committee. A majority of the Committee will constitute a quorum. Every act done or decision made by a majority of the Committee members present at a meeting duly held at which a quorum is present will be regarded as the act of the Committee. At each meeting, the Committee will hold an executive session for Committee members and Independent Counsel only.

Miscellaneous

The Committee will have the resources and authority appropriate to discharge its responsibilities, including authority to retain experts or consultants, subject to the approval of the Independent Directors.

The Committee will review this Charter periodically, and will recommend any changes to the Board. The Board will initially review this Charter, and thereafter will review any material changes to this Charter recommended by the Committee. Board approval is required for initial adoption and any material changes to this Charter.

Effective Date

Adopted by the Board on January 10, 2008, amended on November 12, 2009 and further amended on January 13, 2010.

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit G

Executive Officer and Director Information

Information regarding the current executive officers of each Company and the principal executive officer and directors of Columbia Management, is shown below.

 

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with the Companies
and Year First Elected
or Appointed to Office

  

Position with Columbia
Management and Year
First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

J. Kevin Connaughton

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

President (Principal Executive Officer)

(2010)

  

Senior Vice President and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products

(2010)

   President, Columbia Funds since 2009 (previously Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, June 2008 – January 2009); President, Atlantic Funds and Nations Funds since 2009; Managing Director of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, December 2004 – April 2010; Treasurer, Columbia Funds, October 2003 – May 2008; Treasurer, the Liberty Funds, Stein Roe Funds and Liberty All-Start Funds, December 2000 – December 2006; Senior Vice President – Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, April 2003 – December 2004; President, Columbia Funds, Liberty Funds and Stein Roe Funds, February 2004 – October 2004

Amy K. Johnson

(Born 1965)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Vice President

(2006)

  

Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer

(2010)

   Chief Administrative Officer, Columbia Management, 2009 – April 2010 (previously Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, 2006 – 2009 and Vice President – Operations and Compliance, 2004 – 2006); Senior Vice President, Columbia Funds, Atlantic Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Director of Product Development – Mutual Funds, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. 2001 – 2004

Jeffrey P. Fox

(Born [1955])

105 Ameriprise Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Treasurer

(2002)

   [None]    Chief Financial Officer, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, LLC (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) and of Seligman Data Corp. since 2008; Vice President – Investment Accounting, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since 2002; Chief Financial Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006

Scott R. Plummer

(Born 1959)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary

(2006)

  

Vice President and Chief Legal Officer

(2005)

   Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, from 2005 to April 2010, and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance from 2004 to 2005); Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since 2010; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since May 2010.

Michael A. Jones

(Born 1959)

100 Federal Street

Boston, MA 02110

  

Vice President

(2010)

  

Director and President

(2010)

   President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from November 2006 to April 2010; previously, co-president and senior managing director at Robeco Investment Management.

Colin Moore

(Born 1958)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Senior Vice President

(2010)

  

Director and Chief Investment Officer

(2010)

   Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2002 to 2007.

 

G-1


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with the Companies
and Year First Elected
or Appointed to Office

  

Position with Columbia
Management and Year
First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Linda J. Wondrack

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Vice President

(2010)

  

Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer

(2010)

   Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Funds, since 2007; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, from June 2005 to April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer of MFS Investment Management (investment management) from August 2004 to May 2005.

Neysa M. Alecu

(Born [1964])

2934 Ameriprise Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Money Laundering Prevention Officer since 11/9/05 and Identity Theft Prevention Officer since 2008    [None]    Vice President – Compliance, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., since 2008; Anti-Money Laundering Officer and Identity Theft Prevent Officer, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) since 2008; Anti-Money Laundering Officer, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., since 2005; Compliance Director, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., 2004 – 2008

Stephen T. Welsh

(Born 1957)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   [None]   

President and Director

(2010)

   President and Director, Columbia Management Services, Inc. from July 2004 to April 2010; Managing Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from August 2007 to April 2010; Vice President, Columbia Funds, since 2006

Brian J. McGrane

[ADDRESS]

   [None]    Director, Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer    [•]

 

G-2


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit H

Director/Trustee Compensation

Total directors/trustees’ fees paid by each Fund and each Company to the directors/trustees are listed below for each Fund’s last fiscal year. No director/trustee listed below received pension or retirement benefits accrued as part of any Fund’s expenses in any Fund’s last fiscal year. All directors/trustees receive reimbursements for reasonable expenses related to their attendance at meetings of the Columbia RiverSource Boards or standing Committees, which are not reflected in the amounts shown.

Independent Director/Trustee Compensation from Funds

 

Fund

   Blatz1      Carlson2      Carlton3      Flynn4      Jones5      Laikind6  

For Funds with fiscal years ending May 31

                 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

   $ 1,495       $ 1,556       $ 1,417       $ 1,469       $ 1,514       $ 1,417   

Amount deferred

     0         0         314         570         0         474   

For Funds with fiscal years ending July 31

                 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

     340         363         327         348         345         344   

Amount deferred

     0         0         50         154         0         169   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

     123         131         119         126         125         125   

Amount deferred

     0         0         17         56         0         62   

For Funds with fiscal years ending December 31

                 

Seligman Capital Fund

     530         545         491         507         530         491   

Amount deferred

     0         0         197         152         0         0   

Seligman Growth Fund

     1,806         1,825         1,672         1,690         1,806         1,672   

Amount deferred

     0         0         669         507         0         0   

 

1

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Blatz deferred $0 of her total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Blatz’s account under that plan was $[•].

2

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Carlson deferred $0 of his total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Carlson’s account under that plan was $[•].

3

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Carlton deferred $64,000 of her total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Carlton’s account under that plan was $[•].

4

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Flynn deferred $49,500 of her total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Flynn’s account under that plan was $[•].

5

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Jones deferred $0 of her total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Jones’ account under that plan was $[•].

6

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Laikind deferred $0 of his total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Laikind’s account under that plan was $[•].

 

Fund

   Lewis7      Maher8      Paglia9      Richie10      Taunton-
Rigby11
 

For Funds with fiscal years ending May 31

              

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

   $ 3,115       $ 1,378       $ 1,514       $ 1,436       $ 1,436   

Amount deferred

     532         1,378         0         0         0   

For Funds with fiscal years ending July 31

              

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

     706         342         345         331         331   

Amount deferred

     133         342         0         0         0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

     254         124         125         120         120   

Amount deferred

     48         124         0         0         0   

For Funds with fiscal years ending December 31

              

Seligman Capital Fund

     1,228         476         545         507         507   

Amount deferred

     184         476         0         0         0   

Seligman Growth Fund

     3,803         1,654         1,825         1,690         1,690   

Amount deferred

     570         1,654         0         0         0   

 

H-1


Table of Contents

 

7

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Lewis deferred $60,000 of his total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Lewis account under that plan was $[•].

8

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Maher deferred $ 155,000 of his total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Maher account under that plan was $[•].

9

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Paglia deferred $0 of her total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Paglia’s account under that plan was $[•].

10

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Richie deferred $0 of his total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Richie’s account under that plan was $[•].

11

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Taunton-Rigby deferred $0 of her total compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Taunton-Rigby’s account under that plan was $[•].

Aggregate Independent Director/Trustee Compensation for Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

     Total Compensation from the RiverSource Fund Complex Paid to Independent
Directors/Trustees for Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009(a)
 

Kathleen Blatz

   $ 172,500   

Arne H. Carlson

   $ 177,500   

Pamela G. Carlton

   $ 160,000   

Patricia M. Flynn

   $ 165,000   

Anne P. Jones

   $ 172,500   

Jeffrey Laikind

   $ 160,000   

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.

   $ 400,000   

John F. Maher

   $ 155,000   

Catherine James Paglia

   $ 177,500   

Leroy C. Richie

   $ 165,000   

Alison Taunton-Rigby

   $ 165,000   

 

(a) Board member compensation is a combination of a base fee and meeting fees, with the exception of the Chair of the Board, who receives a base annual compensation. Payment of compensation is administered by a company providing limited administrative services to the funds and to the Board.

 

H-2


Table of Contents

 

STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

[], 2010

This Statement of Additional Information (the “SAI”) relates to the following proposed reorganizations (the “Reorganizations”):

 

1. Reorganization of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, a series of RiverSource Managers Series, Inc. (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Buying Fund”).

 

2. Reorganization of Seligman Capital Fund, a series of Seligman Capital Fund, Inc. (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Buying Fund”).

 

3. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, a series of RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc. (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Buying Fund”).

 

4. Reorganization of Seligman Growth Fund, a series of Seligman Growth Fund, Inc. (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Buying Fund”).

 

5. Reorganization of RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund, a series of RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc. (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust (a “Buying Fund”).

This SAI contains information which may be of interest to shareholders of the Selling Funds but which is not included in the combined Prospectus/Proxy Statement dated [] (the “Proxy Statement/Prospectus”) which relates to the Reorganizations. As described in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus, the Reorganizations would involve the transfer of all the assets of each Selling Fund in exchange for shares of the Buying Fund and the assumption of all the liabilities of each Selling Fund by the Buying Fund. Each Selling Fund would distribute the Buying Fund shares it receives to its shareholders in complete liquidation of each Selling Fund. This SAI is not a prospectus and should be read in conjunction with the Proxy Statement/Prospectus. The Proxy Statement/Prospectus has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and is available upon request and without charge by writing to the Buying Funds at c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, or by calling 800.345.6611.


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

Additional Information About Each Buying Fund

     1   

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

     2   

Financial Statements

     2   

Appendix A – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

     A-1   

Appendix B – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

     B-1   

Appendix C – Pro forma financial statements of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I and Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

     C-1   


Table of Contents

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ABOUT EACH BUYING FUND

Attached hereto as Appendix A is the Statement of Additional Information of the Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I dated November 1, 2010, as supplemented.

 

1


Table of Contents

 

Attached hereto as Appendix B is the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, dated September  27, 2010, as supplemented.

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRMS

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, located at 125 High Street, Boston, MA 02110-1707, is the independent registered public accounting firm for each of the Buying Funds, providing audit and tax return review services and assistance and consultation in connection with the review of various Securities and Exchange Commission filings. The Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, Financial Highlights and Financial Statements included in Columbia Contrarian Core Fund’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2009 and Semiannual Report to Shareholders for the Period ended March 31, 2010; Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2009 and Semiannual Report to Shareholders for the Period ended March 31, 2010; Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended August 31, 2009 and Semiannual Report to Shareholders for the period ended February 28, 2010 are incorporated by reference into this SAI. The audited financial statements for each Buying Fund included in their respective Annual Reports to Shareholders and incorporated by reference into this SAI have been so included and incorporated in reliance upon the reports of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP given on their authority as experts in auditing and accounting. The audited financial statements for RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, RiverSource Disciplined Small & Mid Cap Equity Fund, RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, Seligman Growth Fund and Seligman Capital Fund incorporated by reference to the Proxy Statement/Prospectus have been so included and incorporated in reliance upon the reports of Ernst & Young LLP given on their authority as experts in auditing and accounting except for the information for the periods ended on or before December 31, 2008 for each of Seligman Growth Fund and Seligman Capital Fund and the information for the periods ended on or before May 31, 2007 for RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund, which has been audited by other auditors.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Pro forma financial statements of the Buying Fund for the Reorganizations are attached hereto as Appendix C.

 

2


Table of Contents

 

Appendix A – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund and Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management®

 

  

COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST I

 

STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

November 1, 2010

 

Fund

              

Columbia Balanced Fund

     

Class A: CBLAX

  

Class B: CBLBX

  

Class C: CBLCX

  

Class R: CBLRX

Class R4*: —

  

Class R5*: —

  

Class Z: CBALX

  

Columbia Bond Fund

        

Class A: CNDAX

  

Class B*: —  

  

Class C: CNDCX

  

Class I: —  

Class T*: —  

  

Class W: CBDWX

  

Class Y: CBFYX

  

Class Z: UMMGX

Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     

Class A: COCTX

  

Class B: CCTBX

  

Class C: CCTCX

  

Class Z: CCTZX

        

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

     

Class A: LCCAX

  

Class B: LCCBX

  

Class C: LCCCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CCCRX

  

Class R4*: —  

  

Class T: SGIEX

  

Class W: CTRWX

Class Z: SMGIX

        

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

     

Class A: LIIAX

  

Class B: CIOBX

  

Class C: CIOCX

  

Class I: —  

Class W: CPIWX

  

Class Z: SRINX

     

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

  

Class A: LBSAX

  

Class B: LBSBX

  

Class C: LBSCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CDIRX

  

Class T: GEQAX

  

Class W: CDVWX

  

Class Z: GSFTX

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

     

Class A: EEMAX

  

Class C: EEMCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: CEMRX

Class W: CEMWX

  

Class Z: UMEMX

     

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     

Class A: EENAX

  

Class B*: —  

  

Class C: EENCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CETRX

  

Class R4*: —  

  

Class Z: UMESX

  

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

     

Class A: LHIAX

  

Class B: CHMBX

  

Class C: CHMCX

  

Class Z: SRHMX

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

     

Class A: COLHX

  

Class B: COHBX

  

Class C: CHYCX

  

Class Z: LHYZX

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Class A: LIBAX

  

Class B: LIBBX

  

Class C: LIBCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CIBRX

  

Class W: CIBWX

  

Class Z: SRBFX

  

Columbia International Bond Fund

     

Class A: CNBAX

  

Class C: CNBCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class Z: CNBZX

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

     

Class A: LEGAX

  

Class B: LEGBX

  

Class C: LEGCX

  

Class E: CLGEX

Class F: CLGFX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: CGWRX

  

Class R4*: —  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class T: GAEGX

  

Class W: CLGWX

  

Class Y: CGFYX

Class Z: GEGTX

        

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

     

Class A: CBSAX

  

Class B: CBSBX

  

Class C: CMCCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CMGRX

  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class T: CBSTX

  

Class W: CMRWX

Class Y: CMGYX

  

Class Z: CLSPX

     

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

     

Class A: CASAX

  

Class C: CASCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class Z: USPAX

 

C-6517 C (11/10)


Table of Contents

Fund

              

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

  

Class A: CREAX

  

Class B: CREBX

  

Class C: CRECX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CRSRX

  

Class R4*: —  

  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class W: CREWX

Class Z: CREEX

        

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  

Class A: ELGAX

  

Class C: ELGCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: URLGX

Class W: CSLWX

  

Class Z: UMLGX

     

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

  

Class A: LSMAX

  

Class B: LSMBX

  

Class C: LSMCX

  

Class I: —  

Class W: CSCWX

  

Class T: SSCEX

  

Class Z: SMCEX

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

  

Class A: CGOAX

  

Class B: CGOBX

  

Class C: CGOCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CCRIX

  

Class Y CSGYX

  

Class Z: CMSCX

  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

  

Class A: CSMIX

  

Class B: CSSBX

  

Class C: CSSCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CSVRX

  

Class Y CSVYX

  

Class Z CSCZX

  

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

  

Class A: COSIX

  

Class B: CLSBX

  

Class C: CLSCX

  

Class R: CSNRX

Class R4*: —  

  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class W: CTTWX

  

Class Z: LSIZX

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

  

Class A: CSVAX

  

Class B: CSVBX

  

Class C: CSRCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CSGRX

  

Class W: CTVWX

  

Class Y CLSYX

  

Class Z: CSVFX

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

  

Class A: LUTAX

  

Class B: LUTBX

  

Class C: LUTCX

  

Class I: —  

Class Z: IUTIX

        

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

  

Class A: EVRAX

  

Class C: EVRCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: URBIX

Class W: CVRWX

  

Class Z: UMBIX

     

This Statement of Additional Information (SAI) is not a prospectus, is not a substitute for reading any prospectus and is intended to be read in conjunction with a Fund’s current prospectus. Share classes marked with an “*” have not yet commenced operations as of the date of this SAI. The most recent annual report for each Fund, which includes the Fund’s audited financial statements for its most recent fiscal period, are incorporated by reference into this SAI.

Copies of the Funds’ current prospectuses and annual and semi-annual reports may be obtained without charge by writing Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, by calling Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or by visiting the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com.


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

SAI PRIMER

     1   

ABOUT THE TRUST

     5   

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

     10   

Certain Investment Activity Limits

     10   

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     10   

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

     13   

Borrowings

     51   

Short Sales

     51   

Lending Securities

     52   

Portfolio Turnover

     53   

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

     53   

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

     59   

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

     59   

The Administrator

     75   

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

     78   

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

     81   

Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

     87   

Other Services Provided

     91   

Distribution and Servicing Plans

     93   

Codes of Ethics

     100   

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

     100   

FUND GOVERNANCE

     101   

The Board

     101   

The Officers

     116   

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

     120   

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

     120   

Brokerage Commissions

     122   

Directed Brokerage

     123   

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

     124   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

     126   

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

     128   

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

     131   

Description of the Trust’s Shares

     131   

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

     134   

Purchase and Redemption

     134   

Offering Price

     137   

TAXATION

     139   

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

     155   

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     191   

APPENDIX A—DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

     A-1   

APPENDIX B—PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

     B-1   

APPENDIX C—SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

     C-1   

APPENDIX D—DESCRIPTION OF STATE RISK FACTORS

     D-1   

APPENDIX E—LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

     E-1   

APPENDIX F—LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

     F-1   


Table of Contents

 

SAI PRIMER

The SAI is a part of the Funds’ registration statement that is filed with the SEC. The registration statement includes the Funds’ prospectuses, the SAI and certain exhibits. The SAI, and any supplements to it, can be found online at www.columbiamanagement.com, or by accessing the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

The SAI generally provides additional information about the Funds that is not required to be in the Funds’ prospectuses. The SAI expands discussions of certain matters described in the Funds’ prospectuses and provides certain additional information about the Funds that may be of interest to some investors. Among other things, the SAI provides information about:

 

   

the organization of the Trust;

 

   

the Funds’ investments;

 

   

the Funds’ investment adviser, investment subadviser(s) (if any) and other service providers, including roles and relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and conflicts of interest;

 

   

the governance of the Funds;

 

   

the Funds’ brokerage practices;

 

   

the share classes offered by the Funds;

 

   

the purchase, redemption and pricing of Fund shares; and

 

   

the application of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Investors may find this information important and helpful. If you have any questions about the Funds, please call Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or contact your financial advisor.

Before reading the SAI, you should consult the Glossary below, which defines certain of the terms used in the SAI.

Glossary

 

1933 Act    Securities Act of 1933, as amended
1934 Act    Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
1940 Act    Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended
Administrative Services Agreement    The administrative services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Administrator
Administrator    Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC
Adviser    Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC
Ameriprise Financial    Ameriprise Financial, Inc.
Balanced Fund    Columbia Balanced Fund
BANA    Bank of America, National Association
Bank of America    Bank of America Corporation
BFDS/DST    Boston Financial Data Services, Inc./DST Systems, Inc.
Board    The Trust’s Board of Trustees

 

1


Table of Contents
Bond Fund    Columbia Bond Fund
Brandes    Brandes Investment Partners, L.P.
CMOs    Collateralized mortgage obligations
Code    Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
Codes of Ethics    The codes of ethics adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act
Columbia Funds Complex    The mutual fund complex that is comprised of the open-end investment management companies advised by the Adviser or its affiliates and principally underwritten by Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., including funds using the RiverSource, Threadneedle and Seligman brands and funds using the Columbia brand
Columbia Funds or Columbia Funds Family    The funds within the Columbia Funds Complex using the Columbia brand
Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund    Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund
Contrarian Core Fund    Columbia Contrarian Core Fund
Corporate Income Fund    Columbia Corporate Income Fund
Custodian or State Street    State Street Bank and Trust Company
Distribution Agreement    The distribution agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Distributor
Distribution Plan(s)    One or more of the plans adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act for the distribution of the Funds’ shares
Distributor    Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc.
Dividend Income Fund    Columbia Dividend Income Fund
Emerging Markets Fund    Columbia Emerging Markets Fund
Energy and Natural Resources Fund    Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund
FDIC    Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
FHLMC    The Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
Fitch    Fitch, Inc.
FNMA    Federal National Mortgage Association
The Fund(s) or a Fund    One or more of the open-end management investment companies listed on the front cover of this SAI that are series of the Trust.
GNMA    Government National Mortgage Association
High Yield Municipal Fund    Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund
High Yield Opportunity Fund    Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund
Independent Trustees    The Trustees of the Board who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds
Interested Trustee    A Trustee of the Board who is currently treated as an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds

 

2


Table of Contents
Intermediate Bond Fund    Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund
International Bond Fund    Columbia International Bond Fund
Investment Management Services Agreement    The investment management services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Adviser
IRS    United States Internal Revenue Service
Large Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund
LIBOR    London Interbank Offered Rate
Marsico    Marsico Capital Management, LLC
Mid Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund
Moody’s    Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.
NASDAQ    National Association of Securities Dealers Automated Quotations system
NRSRO    Nationally recognized statistical ratings organization (such as Moody’s, Fitch or S&P)
NSCC    National Securities Clearing Corporation
NYSE    New York Stock Exchange
Pacific/Asia Fund    Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund
Previous Administrator    Columbia Management Advisors, LLC
Previous Adviser    Columbia Management Advisors, LLC
Previous Distributor    Columbia Management Distributors, Inc.
Previous Transfer Agent    Columbia Management Services, Inc.
Real Estate Equity Fund    Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund
REIT    Real estate investment trust
REMIC    Real estate mortgage investment conduit
RIC    A “regulated investment company,” as such term is used in the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
S&P    Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“Standard & Poor’s” and “S&P” are trademarks of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. and have been licensed for use by the Adviser. The Columbia Funds are not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by Standard & Poor’s and Standard & Poor’s makes no representation regarding the advisability of investing in the Columbia Funds).
SAI    This Statement of Additional Information
SEC    United States Securities and Exchange Commission
Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Selling Agent(s)    One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a sales support agreement with the Distributor
Servicing Agent(s)    One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a shareholder servicing agreement with the Distributor

 

3


Table of Contents
Small Cap Core Fund    Columbia Small Cap Core Fund
Small Cap Growth Fund I    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I
Small Cap Value Fund I    Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I
Strategic Income Fund    Columbia Strategic Income Fund
Strategic Investor Fund    Columbia Strategic Investor Fund
Transfer Agency Agreement    The transfer agency agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.
Transfer Agent    Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.
The Trust    Columbia Funds Series Trust I, the registered investment company in the Columbia Funds Family to which this SAI relates
Trustee(s)    One or more of the Board’s Trustees
U.S. Treasury Index Fund    Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Value and Restructuring Fund    Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

 

4


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE TRUST

The Trust is a registered investment company under the 1940 Act within the Columbia Funds Family. Columbia Funds currently include more than 100 mutual funds in major asset classes.

The Trust was organized as a Massachusetts business trust in 1987. On September 23, 2005, the Trust changed its name from Columbia Funds Trust IX to its current name. On October 13, 2003, the Trust changed its name from Liberty-Stein Roe Funds Municipal Trust to Columbia Funds Trust IX.

Funds and portfolios that bore the “Columbia” and “Columbia Acorn” brands prior to September 27, 2010 are collectively referred to herein as the Legacy Columbia funds. For a list of Legacy Columbia funds, see Appendix E. Funds and portfolios that historically bore the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle brands, including those renamed to bear the “Columbia” brand effective September 27, 2010, as well as certain other funds are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds. For a list of Legacy RiverSource funds, see Appendix F.

Funds with fiscal years ending March 31

Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, and Value and Restructuring Fund

Each of Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, and Value and Restructuring Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end management investment company. Each of the Funds is a diversified fund, except Energy and Natural Resources Fund, which is a non-diversified Fund. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of March 31st.

On March 31, 2008, each of Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, and Value and Restructuring Fund, together with the Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia International Growth Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Select Small Cap Fund, and Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund, acquired all assets and assumed all liabilities of, respectively, the following funds, each of which is a series of Excelsior Funds Trust or Excelsior Funds, Inc., as applicable: Blended Equity Fund, Core Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, International Fund, Mid Cap Core Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, Equity Opportunities Fund, Small Cap Fund, Intermediate-Term Bond Fund and Value and Restructuring Fund (the Predecessor Funds), each a series of Excelsior Funds Trust or Excelsior Funds, Inc., as applicable. For periods prior to March 31, 2008, the performance and financial information shown for each Fund is the performance and financial information of the corresponding Predecessor Fund. The Funds commenced operations on March 31, 2008.

Bond Fund offers eight classes of shares; Emerging Markets Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund and Value and Restructuring Fund offer six classes of shares; Energy and Natural Resources Fund offers seven classes of shares; and Pacific/Asia Fund offers four classes of shares, each as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Corporate Income Fund and Intermediate Bond Fund

Each of Corporate Income Fund and Intermediate Bond Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of March 31st. Prior to March 27, 2006, each Fund was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust VIII, a Massachusetts business trust. The information provided for each Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to such predecessor fund. Corporate Income Fund commenced investment operations on March 5, 1986. Intermediate Bond Fund commenced investment operations on December 5, 1978.

 

5


Table of Contents

 

Intermediate Bond Fund offers seven classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. Prior to July 31, 2000, the Fund had a single class of shares. On July 14, 2000, the outstanding shares of the Fund were converted into Class S shares, and on July 31, 2000, the Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On February 1, 2002, the Fund commenced offering Class B and C shares. On July 29, 2002, the Fund’s Class S shares were redesignated as Class Z shares. On January 23, 2006, the Fund commenced offering Class R shares. Prior to September 12, 2002, the Fund invested all of its assets in the SR&F Intermediate Bond Portfolio as part of a master fund/feeder fund structure. Effective October 13, 2003, the Fund changed its name from Liberty Intermediate Bond Fund to its current name. Effective February 1, 2002, the Fund changed its name from Stein Roe Intermediate Bond Fund to Liberty Intermediate Bond Fund.

Corporate Income Fund offers six classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. Prior to August 1, 2000, the Fund had a single class of shares. On that date, the outstanding shares of the Fund were converted into Class S shares, and the Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On July 15, 2002, the Fund added Class B and C shares, redesignated its Class S shares as Class Z shares, and changed its name from Stein Roe Income Fund to Liberty Income Fund. Prior to July 15, 2002, the Fund invested all of its assets in the SR&F Income Portfolio as part of a master fund/feeder fund structure. On October 13, 2003, the Fund changed its name from Liberty Income Fund to Income Fund. Effective September 27, 2010, the Fund changed its name from Income Fund to its current name.

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

U.S. Treasury Index Fund represents a series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. U.S. Treasury Index Fund has a fiscal year end of March 31st. Prior to March 27, 2006, the Fund was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust V, a Massachusetts business trust. The information provided for U.S. Treasury Index Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to such predecessor fund. The predecessor fund commenced investment operations on June 4, 1991. The predecessor fund was the successor by reorganization to the Galaxy II U.S. Treasury Fund, a series of The Galaxy Fund II, a Massachusetts business trust organized on February 22, 1990. Class Z shares of the predecessor fund were issued in exchange for existing shares of the Galaxy II U.S. Treasury Fund. The reorganization occurred on November 25, 2002. All references to U.S. Treasury Index Fund prior to November 25, 2002 shall be deemed to refer to the Galaxy II U.S. Treasury Fund.

U.S. Treasury Index Fund offers five classes of shares, as described in “Capital Stock and Other Securities.” Effective October 13, 2003, U.S. Treasury Index Fund changed its name from Liberty U.S. Treasury Index Fund to its current name.

Funds with fiscal years ending May 31

High Yield Opportunity Fund, International Bond Fund and Strategic Income Fund

Each of High Yield Opportunity Fund, International Bond Fund and Strategic Income Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company, except for International Bond Fund, which is an open-end non-diversified management investment company. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of May 31st.

Prior to March 27, 2006 and September 26, 2005, respectively, High Yield Opportunity Fund and Strategic Income Fund were organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust I, a Massachusetts business trust. The information provided for High Yield Opportunity Fund and Strategic Income Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 and September 26, 2005, respectively, relates to the corresponding series of such predecessor trust.

High Yield Opportunity Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. On October 21, 1971, High Yield Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On June 8, 1992, High Yield Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class B shares. On January 15, 1996, High Yield

 

6


Table of Contents

Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class C shares. On January 8, 1999, High Yield Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class Z shares. Effective October 13, 2003, High Yield Opportunity Fund changed its name from Liberty High Yield Securities Fund to its current name. Effective July 14, 2000, High Yield Opportunity Fund changed its name from Colonial High Yield Securities Fund to Liberty High Yield Securities Fund.

International Bond Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. On December 1, 2008, International Bond Fund commenced offering Class A, C and Z shares.

Strategic Income Fund offers eight classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. On April 22, 1977, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On May 15, 1992, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class B shares. On July 1, 1997, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class C shares. On November 2, 1998, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class J shares. On June 12, 2009, Strategic Income Fund stopped accepting Class J share purchases. On July 27, 2009, Strategic Income Fund liquidated and terminated Class J shares. On January 29, 1999, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class Z shares.

Funds with fiscal years ending June 30

High Yield Municipal Fund and Small Cap Value Fund I

Each of High Yield Municipal Fund and Small Cap Value Fund I represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of such Funds has a fiscal year end of June 30th.

High Yield Municipal Fund commenced investment operations on March 5, 1984. The Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. Prior to August 1, 2000, the Fund had a single class of shares. On that date, the outstanding shares of the Fund were converted into Class S shares, and the Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On July 15, 2002, the Fund added Class B and Class C shares and redesignated Class S shares as Class Z shares. Also on July 15, 2002, the Fund changed its name from “Stein Roe High-Yield Municipals Fund” to “Liberty High Yield Municipal Fund” and the Fund’s Class A shares changed their name from “Liberty High Income Municipals Fund, Class A,” to Class A shares. The Fund invested all of its assets in SR&F High Yield Municipals Portfolio as part of a master fund/feeder fund structure through July 15, 2002. The Fund changed its name from “Liberty High Yield Municipal Fund” to its current name effective October 13, 2003.

Small Cap Value Fund I commenced operations on July 25, 1986. Small Cap Value Fund I was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust VI, a Massachusetts business trust, prior to its reorganization as a series of the Trust on March 27, 2006. The information provided for Small Cap Value Fund I in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to Columbia Funds Trust VI.

Small Cap Value Fund I offers seven classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. The Fund changed its name from “Colonial Small Stock Fund” to “Colonial Small-Cap Value Fund” on February 28, 1997, and from “Colonial Small-Cap Value Fund” to “Liberty Small-Cap Value Fund” on July 14, 2000. The Fund changed its name from “Liberty Small-Cap Value Fund” to “Columbia Small Cap Value Fund” on October 13, 2003. The Fund changed its name from “Columbia Small Cap Value Fund” to its current name effective October 10, 2005.

Funds with fiscal years ending August 31

Balanced Fund, Mid Cap Growth Fund, Small Cap Growth Fund I, and Strategic Investor Fund

Each of Balanced Fund, Mid Cap Growth Fund, Small Cap Growth Fund I and Strategic Investor Fund is a diversified series of the Trust and has a fiscal year end of August 31st.

 

7


Table of Contents

 

Prior to March 27, 2006, each Fund was organized as an Oregon corporation. The information provided for these Funds in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to the predecessor Oregon corporation funds.

Balanced Fund and Small Cap Growth Fund I offer seven classes of shares, Mid Cap Growth Fund offers ten classes of shares and Strategic Investor Fund offers eight classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Funds with fiscal years ending September 30

Contrarian Core Fund, Dividend Income Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, and Small Cap Core Fund

Each of Contrarian Core Fund, Dividend Income Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, and Small Cap Core Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of such Funds has a fiscal year end of September 30th.

Large Cap Growth Fund commenced operations on December 14, 1990; commenced operations on September 1, 1988; and Dividend Income Fund commenced operations on March 4, 1998. Contrarian Core Fund and Small Cap Core Fund commenced operations on December 14, 1992, as separate portfolios (collectively, the Predecessor Shawmut Funds) of The Shawmut Funds. On December 4, 1995, the Predecessor Shawmut Funds were reorganized as new portfolios of the Galaxy Fund. Prior to the reorganization, the Predecessor Shawmut Funds offered and sold shares of beneficial interest that were similar to the Galaxy Fund’s Trust Shares and Retail A Shares. Contrarian Core Fund changed its name from Columbia Common Stock Fund to its current name on November 14, 2008.

Each Fund is the successor to a separate series of the Galaxy Fund, a Massachusetts business trust organized on March 31, 1986. On November 18, 2002, November 25, 2002 and December 9, 2002, the series of the Galaxy Fund to which the Funds succeeded were reorganized as separate series of the Liberty-Stein Roe Investment Trust. Class A shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Prime A Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund, Class B shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Prime B Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund, Class T shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Retail A Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund, Class G shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Retail B Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund and Class Z shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Trust Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund. (Prime A and Prime B Shares, Retail A and Retail B Shares and Trust Shares together are referred to herein as the Predecessor Classes). On August 8, 2007, Class G shares of the Funds were converted to Class T shares. Information provided with respect to each Fund for periods prior to such Fund’s inception relates to the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund. Further, information provided with respect to each class of each Fund prior to such Fund’s inception relates to the Predecessor Classes of such class.

Contrarian Core Fund offers nine classes of shares; Dividend Income Fund offers eight classes of shares; Large Cap Growth Fund offers thirteen classes of shares; and Small Cap Core Fund offers seven classes of shares, each as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Fund with fiscal year ending October 31

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end management investment company. Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund is a “diversified” fund and has a fiscal year end of October 31st.

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund was originally organized as a series of another Massachusetts business trust prior to its reorganization as a series of the Trust. Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund was reorganized as a series of the Trust on March 27, 2006 (the Tax-Exempt Fund Reorganization Date). Prior to March 27, 2006, Connecticut

 

8


Table of Contents

Tax-Exempt Fund was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust V. Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund commenced investment operations on November 1, 1991. The information provided for Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund in this SAI for periods prior to the Tax-Exempt Fund Reorganization Date relates to the predecessor funds of the same names. The trust of which Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund was previously a series changed its name from Liberty Funds Trust V to Columbia Funds Trust V on October 13, 2003.

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Fund with fiscal year ending December 31

Real Estate Equity Fund

Real Estate Equity Fund represents a series of the Trust and is an open-end non-diversified management investment company. In 2009, Real Estate Equity Fund changed its fiscal year end from August 31 to December 31.

Prior to March 27, 2006, Real Estate Equity Fund was organized as an Oregon corporation. The information provided for the Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to the predecessor Oregon corporation.

Real Estate Equity Fund offers nine classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

 

9


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

The investment objectives, principal investment strategies (i.e., as used in this SAI and the corresponding prospectuses, a strategy which generally involves the ability to invest 10% or more of a Fund’s total assets) and related principal risks for each Fund are discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Certain Investment Activity Limits

The overall investment and other activities of the Adviser and its affiliates may limit the investment opportunities for each Fund in certain markets where limitations are imposed by regulators upon the amount of investment by affiliated investors, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. From time to time, each Fund’s activities also may be restricted because of regulatory restrictions applicable to the Adviser and its affiliates and/or because of their internal policies. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

The following discussion of “fundamental” and “non-fundamental” investment policies and limitations for each Fund supplements the discussion of investment policies in the Funds’ prospectuses. A fundamental policy may be changed only with Board and shareholder approval. A non-fundamental policy may be changed by the Board and does not require shareholder approval, but may require notice to shareholders in certain instances.

Unless otherwise noted, whenever an investment policy or limitation states a maximum percentage of a Fund’s assets that may be invested in any security or other asset, or sets forth a policy regarding an investment standard, compliance with such percentage limitation or standard will be determined solely at the time of the Fund’s acquisition of such security or asset. Borrowings and other instruments that may give rise to leverage and the restriction on investing in illiquid securities are monitored on an ongoing basis.

Fundamental Investment Policies

The 1940 Act provides that a “vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities” means the affirmative vote of the lesser of (1) more than 50% of the outstanding shares of a Fund, or (2) 67% or more of the shares present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding shares are represented at the meeting in person or by proxy. The following fundamental investment policies cannot be changed without such a vote.

Each Fund may not, as a matter of fundamental policy:

 

  1. Underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies;

 

  2. Purchase or sell real estate, except each Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein;

 

  3. Purchase or sell commodities, except that each Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts;

 

10


Table of Contents

 

  4.

With the exception of Real Estate Equity Fund, which will invest at least 65% of the value of its total assets in securities of companies principally engaged in the real estate industrya, purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisionsb; (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief; and (iii) under normal market conditions, Energy and Natural Resources Fund will invest at least 25% of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase in the securities of issuers conducting their principal business activities in the energy and other natural resources groups of industriesc;

 

  5. Make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief;

 

  6. Borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief; and

 

  7. With the exception of Energy and Natural Resources Fund, International Bond Fund and Real Estate Equity Fund, purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.

As a matter of fundamental policy, under normal circumstances, Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund invests at least 80% of total assets in state bonds, subject to applicable state requirements.

 

a

In determining whether a purchase by Real Estate Equity Fund would cause the Fund to have invested less than 65% of the value of its total assets in securities of companies principally engaged in the real estate industry, the Adviser currently uses the Global Industry Classification Standard (“GICS”) produced by S&P and MSCI Inc.

b

For purposes of determining whether International Bond Fund has invested 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry pursuant to fundamental investment policy (4) above, the Fund will consider each foreign government to be conducting its business activities in a separate industry, and will consider a security to have been issued by a foreign government if (i) the security is issued directly by such government, (ii) the security is issued by an agency, instrumentality or authority that is backed by the full faith and credit of such foreign government or (iii) the security is issued by an entity the assets and revenues of which the Adviser determines are not separate from such foreign government. The Fund generally will treat supranational entities as issuers separate and distinct from any foreign government, so long as such entities do not fall within the characteristics described in item (iii) above. If any other security is guaranteed as to payment of principal and/or interest by a foreign government, then the Fund will generally treat the guarantee as a separate security issued by such foreign government.

c

In determining whether Energy and Natural Resources Fund has invested at least 25% of the value of its total assets in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the energy and other natural resources groups of industries, the Adviser currently uses the Global Industry Classification Standard (“GICS”) produced by S&P and MSCI Inc. The Adviser currently considers companies in each of the indicated GICS industry groups to be within the energy and other natural resources groups of industries: (i) Energy, (ii) Utilities, and (iii) Materials, but limited to companies in the following

 

11


Table of Contents
 

GICS industries and sub-industries: the Chemicals industry (companies that primarily produce or distribute industrial and basic chemicals, including the Commodity Chemicals, Diversified Chemicals, Fertilizers & Agriculture Chemicals, Industrial Gases, and Specialty Chemicals sub-industries), the Metals & Mining industry (companies that primarily produce, process, extract, or distribute precious or basic metals or minerals, including the Aluminum, Diversified Metals & Mining, Gold, Precious Metals & Minerals, and Steel sub-industries), and the Paper & Forest Products industry (companies that primarily cultivate or manufacture timber or wood-related products or paper products, including the Forest Products and Paper Products sub-industries).

Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

 

Fund

   May Not Invest
more than 15%
of its net assets
in illiquid
securitiesa
     May not sell
securities
shortb
     May not
purchase
securities of
other investment
companiesc
     May not purchase
securities of
companies for
purpose of
exercising controld
     Provides 60
day notice in
connection with
Rule 35d-1
changese
 

Balanced Fund

   ü            ü           

Bond Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   ü         ü         ü           

Contrarian Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Corporate Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Dividend Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Emerging Markets Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

High Yield Municipal Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

High Yield Opportunity Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Intermediate Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

International Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Large Cap Growth Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Pacific/Asia Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Real Estate Equity Fund

   ü            ü           

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Small Cap Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   ü            ü            ü     

Small Cap Value Fund I

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Strategic Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü           

Strategic Investor Fund

   ü            ü           

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Value and Restructuring Fund

   ü            ü           

 

a

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, invest more than 15% of their net assets in illiquid securities. “Illiquid Securities” is defined in accordance with the SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is a security which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which the fund has valued the security.

b

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

c

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations

 

12


Table of Contents
 

thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of one of these Funds are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.

d

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, purchase securities of companies for the purpose of exercising control.

e

To the extent a Fund with a check mark in this column is subject to Rule 35d-1 under the 1940 Act (the Names Rule), and does not otherwise have a fundamental investment policy in place to comply with the Names Rule, such Fund has adopted the following non-fundamental policy: Shareholders will receive at least 60 days’ notice of any change to the Fund’s investment objective or principal investment strategies made in order to comply with the Names Rule. The notice will be provided in plain English in a separate written document, and will contain the following prominent statement or similar statement in bold-face type: “Important Notice Regarding Change in Investment Policy.” This statement will appear on both the notice and the envelope in which it is delivered, unless it is delivered separately from other communications to investors, in which case the statement will appear either on the notice or the envelope in which the notice is delivered.

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

Each Fund’s prospectuses identify and summarize the individual types of securities in which the Fund invests as part of its principal investment strategies and the principal risks associated with such investments.

The table below identifies certain types of securities in which each Fund is permitted to invest, including certain types of securities that are described in each Fund’s prospectuses. A Fund generally has the ability to invest 10% or more of its total assets in each type of security described in its prospectuses (and in each sub-category of such security type described in this SAI). To the extent that a type of security identified below for a Fund is not described in the Fund’s prospectuses (or as a sub-category of such security type in this SAI), the Fund generally invests less than 10% of the Fund’s total assets in such security type.

Information about individual types of securities (including certain of their associated risks) in which some or all of the Funds may invest is set forth below. Each Fund’s investment in these types of securities is subject to its investment objective and fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies.

Temporary Defensive Positions. Each Fund may temporarily invest in money market instruments or hold cash. It may do so without limit, when the Adviser or the Fund’s subadviser, if applicable: (i) believes that the market conditions are not favorable for profitable investing; (ii) is unable to locate favorable investment opportunities; or (iii) determines that a temporary defensive position is advisable or necessary in order to meet anticipated redemption requests, or for other reasons. While a Fund engages in such strategies, it may not achieve its investment objective. See also About the Funds’ Investments – Permissible Investments and Related Risks – Money Market Instruments.

 

13


Table of Contents

 

Permissible Fund Investments

 

Investment Type

  Balanced
Fund
     Bond
Fund
     Connecticut
Tax-Exempt
Fund
    Contrarian  Core
Fund
    Corporate
Income

Fund
    Dividend
Income
Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Bank Obligations

             

Domestic

  ü         ü         ü           

Foreign

  ü         ü         ü           

Common Stock

  ü         ü         ü        ü          ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

     ü              

Derivatives

             

Index or Linked Securities
(Structured Products)

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü         ü           ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts
(Funding Arrangements)

     ü              

Illiquid Securities

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü              ü          ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Municipal Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Participation Interests

  ü         ü              

Preferred Stock

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü         ü           ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

     ü         ü          ü       

Stripped Securities

  ü         ü              

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü         ü         ü        ü          ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

14


Table of Contents

 

Investment Type

  Emerging
Markets

Fund
    Energy and
Natural
Resources
Fund
    High Yield
Municipal
Fund
    High Yield
Opportunity
Fund
    Intermediate
Bond Fund
    International
Bond Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

           

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Derivatives

           

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

15


Table of Contents

 

Investment Type

  Large Cap
Growth
Fund
     Mid Cap
Growth
Fund
     Pacific/Asia
Fund
     Real  Estate
Equity

Fund
     Select Large
Cap Growth
Fund
     Small Cap
Core Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

        ü            ü        

Bank Obligations

                

Domestic

     ü         ü         ü         ü        

Foreign

     ü         ü         ü         ü        

Common Stock

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

        ü            ü        

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

        ü            ü        

Derivatives

                

Index or Linked Securities
(Structured Products)

  ü            ü            ü         ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Dollar Rolls

        ü            ü        

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

        ü            ü        

Illiquid Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

        ü            ü        

Money Market Instruments

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

        ü            ü        

Municipal Securities

        ü            ü        

Participation Interests

        ü            ü        

Preferred Stock

  ü         ü         ü            ü         ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü            ü            ü         ü     

Standby Commitments

        ü            ü        

Stripped Securities

        ü            ü        

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü            ü            ü         ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

 

16


Table of Contents

 

Investment Type

  Small Cap
Growth

Fund I
    Small Cap
Value

Fund  I
    Strategic
Income

Fund
    Strategic
Investor

Fund
    U.S.
Treasury
Fund
    Value and
Restructuring
Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

    ü        ü            ü     

Bank Obligations

           

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

    ü        ü            ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

      ü            ü     

Derivatives

           

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

    ü        ü            ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Dollar Rolls

      ü            ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

      ü            ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

      ü            ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

      ü            ü     

Municipal Securities

      ü            ü     

Participation Interests

      ü            ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

    ü        ü            ü     

Standby Commitments

    ü        ü            ü     

Stripped Securities

      ü            ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

    ü        ü            ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Asset-Backed Securities

Asset-backed securities represent interests in, or debt instruments that are backed by, pools of various types of assets that generate cash payments generally over fixed periods of time. Such securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying assets (less fees paid to the

 

17


Table of Contents

originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying assets effectively pass through to such security holders. Asset-backed securities typically are created by an originator of loans or owner of accounts receivable that sells such underlying assets to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying assets, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Asset-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in asset-backed securities is subject to certain risks. For example, the value of asset-backed securities may be affected by, among other factors, changes in: interest rates, the market’s assessment of the quality of underlying assets, the creditworthiness of the servicer for the underlying assets, information concerning the originator of the underlying assets, or the creditworthiness or rating of the entities that provide any supporting letters of credit, surety bonds, derivative instruments, or other credit enhancement. The value of asset-backed securities also will be affected by the exhaustion, termination or expiration of any credit enhancement.

Declining or low interest rates may lead to a more rapid rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in accelerated payments on asset-backed securities that then would be reinvested at a lesser rate of interest. Rising or high interest rates tend to lead to a slower rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in slower than expected payments on asset-backed securities that can, in turn, lead to a decline in value. The impact of changing interest rates on the value of asset-backed securities may be difficult to predict and result in greater volatility. Holders of asset-backed securities generally have no recourse against the originator of the underlying assets in the event of a default on the underlying assets. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of asset-backed securities, backed by pools of receivables such as mortgage loans, may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or an underlying obligor has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for asset-backed securities that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of an asset-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be.

Bank Obligations (Domestic and Foreign)

Bank obligations include certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances, time deposits and promissory notes that earn a specified rate of return and may be issued by (i) a domestic branch of a domestic bank, (ii) a foreign branch of a domestic bank, (iii) a domestic branch of a foreign bank or (iv) a foreign branch of a foreign bank. Bank obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

Certificates of deposit, or so-called CDs, typically are interest-bearing debt instruments issued by banks and have maturities ranging from a few weeks to several years. Bankers’ acceptances are time drafts drawn on and accepted by banks, are a customary means of effecting payment for merchandise sold in import-export transactions and are a general source of financing. Yankee dollar certificates of deposit are negotiable CDs issued in the United States by branches and agencies of foreign banks. Eurodollar certificates of deposit are CDs issued by foreign (mainly European) banks with interest and principal paid in U.S. dollars. Such CDs typically have maturities of less than two years and have interest rates that typically are pegged to the London Interbank Offered Rate or LIBOR. A time deposit can be either a savings account or CD that is an obligation of a financial institution for a fixed term. Typically, there are penalties for early withdrawals of time deposits. Promissory notes are written commitments of the maker to pay the payee a specified sum of money either on demand or at a fixed or determinable future date, with or without interest.

 

18


Table of Contents

 

Bank investment contracts are issued by banks. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of a bank. The bank then credits to the Fund payments at floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund also may hold funds on deposit with its custodian for temporary purposes.

Investing in bank obligations is subject to certain risks. Certain bank obligations, such as some CDs, are insured by the FDIC up to certain specified limits. Many other bank obligations, however, are neither guaranteed nor insured by the FDIC or the U.S. Government. These bank obligations are “backed” only by the creditworthiness of the issuing bank or parent financial institution. Domestic and foreign banks are subject to different governmental regulation. Accordingly, certain obligations of foreign banks, including Eurodollar and Yankee dollar obligations, involve different investment risks than those affecting obligations of domestic banks, including, among others, the possibilities that: (i) their liquidity could be impaired because of political or economic developments; (ii) the obligations may be less marketable than comparable obligations of domestic banks; (iii) a foreign jurisdiction might impose withholding and other taxes at high levels on interest income; (iv) foreign deposits may be seized or nationalized; (v) foreign governmental restrictions such as exchange controls may be imposed, which could adversely affect the payment of principal or interest on those obligations; (vi) there may be less publicly available information concerning foreign banks issuing the obligations; and (vii) the reserve requirements and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards, practices and requirements applicable to foreign banks may differ from those applicable to domestic banks. Foreign banks generally are not subject to examination by any U.S. Government agency or instrumentality.

Common Stock

Common stock represents a unit of equity ownership of a corporation. Owners typically are entitled to vote on the selection of directors and other important corporate governance matters, and to receive dividend payments, if any, on their holdings. However, ownership of common stock does not entitle owners to participate in the day-to-day operations of the corporation. Common stocks of domestic and foreign public corporations can be listed, and their shares traded, on domestic stock exchanges, such as the NYSE or the NASDAQ Stock Market. Domestic and foreign corporations also may have their shares traded on foreign exchanges, such as the London Stock Exchange or Tokyo Stock Exchange. Common stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in common stocks is subject to certain risks. Stock market risk, for example, is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods of time, perhaps substantially or unexpectedly. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when stock prices generally rise and periods when stock prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and fall based on factors specific to each company, such as changes in earnings or management, as well as general economic and market factors.

If a corporation is liquidated, the claims of secured and unsecured creditors and owners of debt securities and “preferred” stock take priority over the claims of those who own common stock.

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to the particular type of company issuing the common stock. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price swings than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, may be more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Common stocks of these types of companies may have a higher potential for gains, but also may be subject to greater risk of loss.

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of common stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably

 

19


Table of Contents

affect, an industry, the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry to decline quickly.

Convertible Securities

Convertible securities include bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks or other securities that may be converted or exchanged (by the holder or by the issuer) into shares of the underlying common stock (or cash or securities of equivalent value) at a stated exchange ratio or predetermined price (the conversion price). As such, convertible securities combine the investment characteristics of debt securities and equity securities. A holder of convertible securities is entitled to receive the income of a bond, debenture or note or the dividend of a preferred stock until the conversion privilege is exercised. The market value of convertible securities generally is a function of, among other factors, interest rates, the rates of return of similar nonconvertible securities and the financial strength of the issuer. The market value of convertible securities tends to decline as interest rates rise and, conversely, to rise as interest rates decline. However, a convertible security’s market value tends to reflect the market price of the common stock of the issuing company when that stock price approaches or is greater than its conversion price. As the market price of the underlying common stock declines, the price of the convertible security tends to be influenced more by the rate of return of the convertible security. Because both interest rate and market movements can influence their value, convertible securities generally are not as sensitive to changes in interest rates as similar debt securities nor generally are they as sensitive to changes in share price as their underlying common stock. Convertible securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in convertible securities is subject to certain risks. Certain convertible securities, particularly securities that are convertible into securities of an issuer other than the issuer of the convertible security, may be illiquid and, therefore, may be more difficult to resell in a timely fashion or for a fair price, which could result in investment losses. Certain convertible securities may have a mandatory conversion feature, pursuant to which the securities convert automatically into common stock or other equity securities (of the same or a different issuer) at a specified date and a specified exchange ratio. Certain convertible securities may be convertible at the option of the issuer, which may require a holder to convert the security into the underlying common stock, even at times when the value of the underlying common stock or other equity security has declined substantially. In addition, some convertible securities may be rated below investment grade or may not be rated and, therefore, may be considered speculative investments. Companies that issue convertible securities frequently are small- and mid-capitalization companies and, accordingly, carry the risks associated with such companies. In addition, the credit rating of a company’s convertible securities generally is lower than that of its conventional debt securities. Convertible securities are senior to equity securities and have a claim to the assets of an issuer prior to the holders of the issuer’s common stock in the event of liquidation but generally are subordinate to similar non-convertible debt securities of the same issuer. Some convertible securities are particularly sensitive to changes in interest rates when their predetermined conversion price is much higher than the price for the issuing company’s common stock.

Corporate Debt Securities

Corporate debt securities are fixed income securities typically issued by businesses to finance their operations. Notes, bonds, debentures and commercial paper are the most common types of corporate debt securities, with the primary difference being their interest rates, maturity dates and secured or unsecured status. Commercial paper has the shortest term and usually is unsecured. The broad category of corporate debt securities includes debt issued by domestic or foreign companies of all kinds, including those with small-, mid- and large-capitalizations. The category also includes bank loans, as well as assignments, participations and other interests

 

20


Table of Contents

in bank loans. Corporate debt securities may be rated investment grade or below investment grade and may be structured as fixed-, variable or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Extendible commercial notes (ECNs) are very similar to commercial paper except that with ECNs, the issuer has the option to extend the notes’ maturity. ECNs are issued at a discount rate, with an initial redemption of not more than 90 days from the date of issue. If ECNs are not redeemed by the issuer on the initial redemption date, the issuer will pay a premium (step-up) rate based on the ECN’s credit rating at the time.

Because of the wide range of types and maturities of corporate debt securities, as well as the range of creditworthiness of issuers, corporate debt securities can have widely varying risk/return profiles. For example, commercial paper issued by a large established domestic corporation that is rated by an NRSRO as investment grade may have a relatively modest return on principal but present relatively limited risk. On the other hand, a long-term corporate note issued, for example, by a small foreign corporation from an emerging market country that has not been rated by an NRSRO may have the potential for relatively large returns on principal but carries a relatively high degree of risk.

Investing in corporate debt securities is subject to certain risks including, among others, credit and interest rate risk. Credit risk is the risk that a Fund could lose money if the issuer of a corporate debt security is unable to pay interest or repay principal when it becomes due. Some corporate debt securities that are rated below investment grade by an NRSRO generally are considered speculative because they present a greater risk of loss, including default, than higher quality debt securities. The credit risk of a particular issuer’s debt security may vary based on its priority for repayment. For example, higher ranking (senior) debt securities have a higher priority than and, therefore, may be paid in full before, lower ranking (subordinated) securities. In addition, in the event of bankruptcy, holders of higher-ranking senior securities may receive amounts otherwise payable to the holders of more junior securities. Interest rate risk is the risk that the value of certain corporate debt securities will tend to fall when interest rates rise. In general, corporate debt securities with longer terms tend to fall more in value when interest rates rise than do corporate debt securities with shorter terms.

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

Custody receipts and trust certificates are derivative products that evidence direct ownership in a pool of securities. Typically, a sponsor will deposit a pool of securities with a custodian in exchange for custody receipts evidencing interests in those securities. The sponsor generally then will sell the custody receipts or trust certificates in negotiated transactions at varying prices. Each custody receipt or trust certificate evidences the individual securities in the pool and the holder of a custody receipt or trust certificate generally will have all the rights and privileges of owners of those securities.

Investing in custody receipts and trust certificates is subject to certain risks. Custody receipts and trust certificates generally are subject to the same risks as the securities evidenced by the receipts or certificates. Custody receipts and trust certificates also may be less liquid than the underlying securities.

Derivatives

General

Derivatives are financial instruments whose values are based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or a bond), assets (such as a commodity, like gold), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Some forms of derivatives, such as exchange-traded futures and options on securities, commodities, or indices, are traded on regulated exchanges. These types of derivatives are

 

21


Table of Contents

standardized contracts that can easily be bought and sold, and whose market values are determined and published daily. Non-standardized derivatives, on the other hand, tend to be more specialized or complex, and may be harder to value. Derivatives afford leverage and, when used properly, can enhance returns and be useful in hedging portfolios. Some common types of derivatives include futures; options; options on futures; forward foreign currency exchange contracts; forward contracts on securities and securities indices; linked securities and structured products; CMOs; stripped securities; warrants; swap agreements and swaptions.

A Fund may use derivatives for a variety of reasons, including, for example: (i) to enhance its return; (ii) to attempt to protect against possible changes in the market value of securities held in or to be purchased for its portfolio resulting from securities markets or currency exchange rate fluctuations (i.e., to hedge); (iii) to protect its unrealized gains reflected in the value of its portfolio securities; (iv) to facilitate the sale of such securities for investment purposes; (v) to reduce transaction costs; and/or (vi) to manage the effective maturity or duration of its portfolio.

A Fund’s use of derivatives presents risks different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in traditional securities. The use of derivatives can lead to losses because of adverse movements in the price or value of the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate, which may be magnified by certain features of the derivatives. These risks are heightened when a Fund uses derivatives to enhance its return or as a substitute for a position or security, rather than solely to hedge or offset the risk of a position or security held by a Fund. There is also a risk that the derivative will not correlate well with the security for which it is substituting. A Fund’s use of derivatives to leverage risk also may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing a Fund to lose more money than if it had invested in the underlying security, or limit a potential gain. The success of management’s derivative strategies will depend on its ability to assess and predict the impact of market or economic developments on the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate and the derivative itself, without necessarily the benefit of observing the performance of the derivative under all possible market conditions. Other risks arise from a Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell its derivative positions as a liquid secondary market for such positions may not exist at times when a Fund may wish to terminate or sell them. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid. Derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. Also, with some derivative strategies there is the risk that a Fund may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to invest in derivatives altogether. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount and accelerate the timing of taxes payable by shareholders.

A Fund may use any or all of the above investment techniques and may purchase different types of derivative instruments at any time and in any combination. There is no particular strategy that dictates the use of one technique over another, as the use of derivatives is a function of numerous variables, including market conditions.

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

General. Indexed or linked securities, also often referred to as “structured products,” are instruments that may have varying combinations of equity and debt characteristics. These instruments are structured to recast the investment characteristics of the underlying security or reference asset. If the issuer is a unit investment trust or other special purpose vehicle, the structuring will typically involve the deposit with or purchase by such issuer of specified instruments (such as commercial bank loans or securities) and/or the execution of various derivative transactions, and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of securities (structured securities) backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying instruments. The cash flow on the underlying instruments may be apportioned among the newly issued structured securities to create securities with different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, payment priorities and interest rate provisions, and the extent of such payments made with respect to structured securities is dependent on the extent of the cash flow on the underlying instruments.

 

22


Table of Contents

 

Indexed and Inverse Floating Rate Securities. A Fund may invest in securities that provide a potential return based on a particular index of value or interest rates. For example, a Fund may invest in securities that pay interest based on an index of interest rates. The principal amount payable upon maturity of certain securities also may be based on the value of the index. To the extent a Fund invests in these types of securities, a Fund’s return on such securities will rise and fall with the value of the particular index: that is, if the value of the index falls, the value of the indexed securities owned by a Fund will fall. Interest and principal payable on certain securities may also be based on relative changes among particular indices.

A Fund may also invest in so-called “inverse floaters” or “residual interest bonds” on which the interest rates vary inversely with a floating rate (which may be reset periodically by a dutch auction, a remarketing agent, or by reference to a short-term tax-exempt interest rate index). A Fund may purchase synthetically-created inverse floating rate bonds evidenced by custodial or trust receipts. Generally, income on inverse floating rate bonds will decrease when interest rates increase, and will increase when interest rates decrease. Such securities have the effect of providing a degree of investment leverage, since they may increase or decrease in value in response to changes, as an illustration, in market interest rates at a rate that is a multiple of the rate at which fixed-rate securities increase or decrease in response to such changes. As a result, the market values of such securities will generally be more volatile than the market values of fixed-rate securities. To seek to limit the volatility of these securities, a Fund may purchase inverse floating obligations that have shorter-term maturities or that contain limitations on the extent to which the interest rate may vary. Certain investments in such obligations may be illiquid. A Fund may invest in indexed and inverse securities for hedging purposes or to seek to increase returns. When used for hedging purposes, indexed and inverse securities involve correlation risk. Furthermore, where such a security includes a contingent liability, in the event of an adverse movement in the underlying index or interest rate, a Fund may be required to pay substantial additional margin to maintain the position.

Credit Linked Securities. Among the income producing securities in which a Fund may invest are credit linked securities. The issuers of these securities frequently are limited purpose trusts or other special purpose vehicles that, in turn, invest in a derivative instrument or basket of derivative instruments, such as credit default swaps, interest rate swaps and other securities, in order to provide exposure to certain fixed income markets. For instance, a Fund may invest in credit linked securities as a cash management tool in order to gain exposure to a certain market and/or to remain fully invested when more traditional income producing securities are not available.

Like an investment in a bond, investments in these credit linked securities represent the right to receive periodic income payments (in the form of distributions) and payment of principal at the end of the term of the security. However, these payments are conditioned on or linked to the issuer’s receipt of payments from, and the issuer’s potential obligations to, the counterparties to the derivative instruments and other securities in which the issuer invests. For instance, the issuer may sell one or more credit default swaps, under which the issuer would receive a stream of payments over the term of the swap agreements provided that no event of default has occurred with respect to the referenced debt obligation upon which the swap is based. If a default occurs, the stream of payments may stop and the issuer would be obligated to pay the counterparty the par (or other agreed upon value) of the referenced debt obligation. This, in turn, would reduce the amount of income and/or principal that a Fund would receive. A Fund’s investments in these instruments are indirectly subject to the risks associated with derivative instruments, including, among others, credit risk, default or similar event risk, counterparty risk, interest rate risk, leverage risk and management risk. These securities generally are exempt from registration under the 1933 Act. Accordingly, there may be no established trading market for the securities and they may constitute illiquid investments.

Index-, Commodity-, Currency- and Equity-Linked Securities. “Index-linked” or “commodity-linked” notes are debt securities of companies that call for interest payments and/or payment at maturity in different terms than the typical note where the borrower agrees to make fixed interest payments and to pay a fixed sum at maturity. Principal and/or interest payments on an index-linked or commodity-linked note depend on the performance of

 

23


Table of Contents

one or more market indices, such as the S&P 500® Index, a weighted index of commodity futures such as crude oil, gasoline and natural gas or the market prices of a particular commodity or basket of commodities. Equity-linked securities are short-term or intermediate term instruments having a value at maturity and/or interest rate determined by reference to the market prices of one or more equity securities. At maturity, the principal amount of an equity-linked debt security is often exchanged for common stock of the issuer or is payable in an amount based on the issuer’s common stock price at the time of maturity. Currency-linked debt securities are short-term or intermediate-term instruments having a value at maturity, and/or an interest rate, determined by reference to one or more foreign currencies. Payment of principal or periodic interest may be calculated as a multiple of the movement of one currency against another currency, or against an index.

Index, commodity, currency and equity-linked securities may entail substantial risks. Such instruments may be subject to significant price volatility. The company issuing the instrument may fail to pay the amount due on maturity. The underlying investment or security may not perform as expected by the Adviser. Markets, underlying securities and indexes may move in a direction that was not anticipated by the Adviser. Performance of the derivatives may be influenced by interest rate and other market changes in the United States and abroad, and certain derivative instruments may be illiquid.

Linked securities are often issued by unit investment trusts. Examples of this include such index-linked securities as S&P Depositary Receipts (SPDRs), which is an interest in a unit investment trust holding a portfolio of securities linked to the S&P 500® Index, and a type of exchange-traded fund (ETF). Because a unit investment trust is an investment company under the 1940 Act, a Fund’s investments in SPDRs are subject to the limitations set forth in Section 12(d)(1)(A) of the 1940 Act. SPDRs closely track the underlying portfolio of securities, trade like a share of common stock and pay periodic dividends proportionate to those paid by the portfolio of stocks that comprise the S&P 500® Index. As a holder of interests in a unit investment trust, a Fund would indirectly bear its ratable share of that unit investment trust’s expenses. At the same time, a Fund would continue to pay its own management and advisory fees and other expenses, as a result of which a Fund and its shareholders in effect would be absorbing levels of fees with respect to investments in such unit investment trusts.

Equity-linked securities include issues such as Structured Yield Product Exchangeable for Stock (STRYPES), Trust Automatic Common Exchange Securities (TRACES), Trust Issued Mandatory Exchange Securities (TIMES), and Trust Enhanced Dividend Securities (TRENDS). The issuers of these equity-linked securities generally purchase and hold a portfolio of stripped U.S. Treasury securities maturing on a quarterly basis through the conversion date, and a forward purchase contract with an existing shareholder of the company relating to the common stock. Quarterly distributions on such equity-linked securities generally consist of the cash received from the U.S. Treasury securities and such equity-linked securities generally are not entitled to any dividends that may be declared on the common stock.

Investing in structured products and linked securities is subject to certain risks. Because structured products typically involve no credit enhancement, their credit risk generally will be equivalent to that of the underlying instruments. Investments in structured products may be structured as a class that is either subordinated or unsubordinated to the right of payment of another class. Subordinated structured products typically have higher rates of return and present greater risks than unsubordinated structured products. Structured products sometimes are sold in private placement transactions and often have a limited trading market.

Investments in “linked” securities have the potential to lead to significant losses because of unexpected movements in the underlying financial asset, index, currency or other investment. The ability of a Fund to utilize linked-securities successfully will depend on its ability correctly to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. Because currency-linked securities usually relate to foreign currencies, some of which may be currencies from emerging market countries, there are certain additional risks associated with such investments.

SPDRs are subject to the risks of an investment in a broadly based portfolio of common stocks, including the risk that the general level of stock prices may decline, thereby adversely affecting the value of such

 

24


Table of Contents

investment. In addition, because individual investments in SPDRs are not redeemable, except upon termination of the unit investment trust, the liquidity of small holdings of SPDRs will depend upon the existence of a secondary market. Large holdings of SPDRs are called “creation unit size” and are redeemable in-kind only and are not redeemable for cash from the unit investment trust. The price of a SPDR is derived from and based upon the securities held by the unit investment trust. Accordingly, the level of risk involved in the purchase or sale of a SPDR is similar to the risk involved in the purchase or sale of traditional common stock, with the exception that the pricing mechanism for SPDRs is based on a basket of stocks. Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying SPDRs purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on SPDRs.

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

Futures Contracts. A futures contract sale creates an obligation by the seller to deliver the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. A futures contract purchase creates an obligation by the purchaser to take delivery of the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. The specific security or other asset delivered or taken at the settlement date is not determined until on or near that date. The determination is made in accordance with the rules of the exchange on which the futures contract was made. A Fund may enter into futures contracts which are traded on national or foreign futures exchanges and are standardized as to maturity date and underlying security or other asset. Futures exchanges and trading in the United States are regulated under the Commodity Exchange Act (CEA) by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), a U.S. Government agency.

Traders in futures contracts may be broadly classified as either “hedgers” or “speculators.” Hedgers use the futures markets primarily to offset unfavorable changes (anticipated or potential) in the value of securities or other assets currently owned or expected to be acquired by them. Speculators less often own the securities or other assets underlying the futures contracts which they trade, and generally use futures contracts with the expectation of realizing profits from fluctuations in the value of the underlying securities or other assets. Pursuant to a notice of eligibility claiming exclusion from the definition of commodity pool operator filed with the CFTC and the National Futures Association on behalf of the Funds, neither the Trust nor any of the individual Funds is deemed to be a “commodity pool operator” under the CEA, and, accordingly, they are not subject to registration or regulation as such under the CEA.

Upon entering into futures contracts, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities, equal in value to the amount of a Fund’s obligation under the contract (less any applicable margin deposits and any assets that constitute “cover” for such obligation), will be segregated with a Fund’s custodian.

Unlike when a Fund purchases or sells a security, no price is paid or received by a Fund upon the purchase or sale of a futures contract, although a Fund is required to deposit with its custodian in a segregated account in the name of the futures broker an amount of cash and/or U.S. Government securities in order to initiate and maintain open positions in futures contracts. This amount is known as “initial margin.” The nature of initial margin in futures transactions is different from that of margin in security transactions, in that futures contract margin does not involve the borrowing of funds by a Fund to finance the transactions. Rather, initial margin is in the nature of a performance bond or good faith deposit intended to assure completion of the contract (delivery or acceptance of the underlying security or other asset) that is returned to a Fund upon termination of the futures contract, assuming all contractual obligations have been satisfied. Minimum initial margin requirements are established by the relevant futures exchange and may be changed. Brokers may establish deposit requirements which are higher than the exchange minimums. Futures contracts are customarily purchased and sold on margin which may range upward from less than 5% of the value of the contract being traded. Subsequent payments, called “variation margin,” to and from the broker (or the custodian) are made on a daily basis as the price of the underlying security or other asset fluctuates, a process known as “marking to market.” If the futures contract price changes to the extent that the margin on deposit does not satisfy margin requirements, payment of additional variation margin will be required. Conversely, a change in the contract value may reduce the required margin, resulting in a repayment of excess margin to the contract holder. Variation margin payments are made for as long as the contract remains open. A Fund expects to earn interest income on its margin deposits.

 

25


Table of Contents

 

Although futures contracts by their terms call for actual delivery or acceptance of securities or other assets (stock index futures contracts or futures contracts that reference other intangible assets do not permit delivery of the referenced assets), the contracts usually are closed out before the settlement date without the making or taking of delivery. A Fund may elect to close some or all of its futures positions at any time prior to their expiration. The purpose of taking such action would be to reduce or eliminate the position then currently held by a Fund. Closing out an open futures position is done by taking an opposite position (“buying” a contract which has previously been “sold,” “selling” a contract previously “purchased”) in an identical contract (i.e., the same aggregate amount of the specific type of security or other asset with the same delivery date) to terminate the position. Final determinations are made as to whether the price of the initial sale of the futures contract exceeds or is below the price of the offsetting purchase, or whether the purchase price exceeds or is below the offsetting sale price. Final determinations of variation margin are then made, additional cash is required to be paid by or released to a Fund, and a Fund realizes a loss or a gain. Brokerage commissions are incurred when a futures contract is bought or sold.

Successful use of futures contracts by a Fund is subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of interest rates and other factors affecting securities and commodities markets. This requires different skills and techniques than those required to predict changes in the prices of individual securities. A Fund, therefore, bears the risk that future market trends will be incorrectly predicted.

The risk of loss in trading futures contracts in some strategies can be substantial, due both to the relatively low margin deposits required and the potential for an extremely high degree of leverage involved in futures contracts. As a result, a relatively small price movement in a futures contract may result in an immediate and substantial loss to the investor. For example, if at the time of purchase, 10% of the value of the futures contract is deposited as margin, a subsequent 10% decrease in the value of the futures contract would result in a total loss of the margin deposit, before any deduction for the transaction costs, if the account were then closed out. A 15% decrease would result in a loss equal to 150% of the original margin deposit if the contract were closed out. Thus, a purchase or sale of a futures contract may result in losses in excess of the amount posted as initial margin for the contract.

In the event of adverse price movements, a Fund would continue to be required to make daily cash payments in order to maintain its required margin. In such a situation, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell portfolio securities in order to meet daily margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. The inability to close the futures position also could have an adverse impact on the ability to hedge effectively.

To reduce or eliminate a hedge position held by a Fund, a Fund may seek to close out a position. The ability to establish and close out positions will be subject to the development and maintenance of a liquid secondary market. It is not certain that this market will develop or continue to exist for a particular futures contract, which may limit a Fund’s ability to realize its profits or limit its losses. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain contracts; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions, closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of contracts, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of contracts (or a particular class or series of contracts), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of contracts) would cease to exist, although outstanding contracts on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

 

26


Table of Contents

 

Interest Rate Futures Contracts. Bond prices are established in both the cash market and the futures market. In the cash market, bonds are purchased and sold with payment for the full purchase price of the bond being made in cash, generally within five business days after the trade. In the futures market, a contract is made to purchase or sell a bond in the future for a set price on a certain date. Historically, the prices for bonds established in the futures markets have tended to move generally in the aggregate in concert with the cash market prices and have maintained fairly predictable relationships. Accordingly, a Fund may use interest rate futures contracts as a defense, or hedge, against anticipated interest rate changes. A Fund presently could accomplish a similar result to that which it hopes to achieve through the use of interest rate futures contracts by selling bonds with long maturities and investing in bonds with short maturities when interest rates are expected to increase, or conversely, selling bonds with short maturities and investing in bonds with long maturities when interest rates are expected to decline. However, because of the liquidity that is often available in the futures market, the protection is more likely to be achieved, perhaps at a lower cost and without changing the rate of interest being earned by a Fund, through using futures contracts.

Interest rate futures contracts are traded in an auction environment on the floors of several exchanges principally, the Chicago Board of Trade, the Chicago Mercantile Exchange and the New York Futures Exchange. Each exchange guarantees performance under contract provisions through a clearing corporation, a nonprofit organization managed by the exchange membership. A public market exists in futures contracts covering various financial instruments including long-term U.S. Treasury Bonds and Notes; GNMA modified pass-through mortgage backed securities; three-month U.S. Treasury Bills; and ninety-day commercial paper. A Fund may also invest in exchange-traded Eurodollar contracts, which are interest rate futures on the forward level of LIBOR. These contracts are generally considered liquid securities and trade on the Chicago Mercantile Exchange. Such Eurodollar contracts are generally used to “lock-in” or hedge the future level of short-term rates. A Fund may trade in any interest rate futures contracts for which there exists a public market, including, without limitation, the foregoing instruments.

Index Futures Contracts. An index futures contract is a contract to buy or sell units of an index at a specified future date at a price agreed upon when the contract is made. Entering into a contract to buy units of an index is commonly referred to as buying or purchasing a contract or holding a long position in the index. Entering into a contract to sell units of an index is commonly referred to as selling a contract or holding a short position in the index. A unit is the current value of the index. A Fund may enter into stock index futures contracts, debt index futures contracts, or other index futures contracts appropriate to its objective(s).

There are several risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. One risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged.

Municipal Bond Index Futures Contracts. Municipal bond index futures contracts may act as a hedge against changes in market conditions. A municipal bond index assigns values daily to the municipal bonds included in the index based on the independent assessment of dealer-to-dealer municipal bond brokers. A municipal bond index futures contract represents a firm commitment by which two parties agree to take or make delivery of an amount equal to a specified dollar amount multiplied by the difference between the municipal bond index value on the last trading date of the contract and the price at which the futures contract is originally struck. No physical delivery of the underlying securities in the index is made.

Options on Futures Contracts. A Fund may purchase and write call and put options on those futures contracts that it is permitted to buy or sell. A Fund may use such options on futures contracts in lieu of writing options directly on the underlying securities or other assets or purchasing and selling the underlying futures contracts. Such options generally operate in the same manner as options purchased or written directly on the underlying investments. A futures option gives the holder, in return for the premium paid, the right to buy from

 

27


Table of Contents

(call) or sell to (put) the writer of the option a futures contract at a specified price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise, the writer of the option is obligated to pay the difference between the cash value of the futures contract and the exercise price. Like the buyer or seller of a futures contract, the holder or writer of an option has the right to terminate its position prior to the scheduled expiration of the option by selling or purchasing an option of the same series, at which time the person entering into the closing purchase transaction will realize a gain or loss. There is no guarantee that such closing purchase transactions can be effected.

A Fund will enter into written options on futures contracts only when, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities equal in value to the underlying security’s or other asset’s value (less any applicable margin deposits) have been deposited in a segregated account. A Fund will be required to deposit initial margin and maintenance margin with respect to put and call options on futures contracts written by it pursuant to brokers’ requirements similar to those described above.

Investments in futures options involve some of the same risks that are involved in connection with investments in futures contracts (for example, the existence of a liquid secondary market). In addition, the purchase of an option also entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option purchased. There may be circumstances when the purchase of a call or put option on a futures contract would result in a loss to a Fund when the purchase or sale of a futures contract would not, such as when there is no movement in the prices of the hedged investments. In general, the market prices of options can be expected to be more volatile than the market prices on the underlying futures contracts. Compared to the purchase or sale of futures contracts, however, the purchase of call or put options on futures contracts may frequently involve less potential risk to a Fund because the maximum amount at risk is the premium paid for the options (plus transaction costs).

Successful use of index futures by a Fund is also subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of the market. It is possible that, for example, where a Fund has sold futures to hedge its portfolio against a decline in the market, the index on which the futures are written may advance and the value of securities held in a Fund’s portfolio may decline. If this occurred, a Fund would lose money on the futures and also experience a decline in the value of its portfolio securities, as a Fund’s ability to effectively hedge all or a portion of the securities in its portfolio, in anticipation of or during a market decline, through transactions in futures or put options on stock indices, depends on the degree to which price movements in the underlying index correlate with the price movements of the securities held by a Fund. Inasmuch as a Fund’s securities will not duplicate the components of an index, the correlation will not be perfect. Consequently, a Fund bears the risk that the prices of its securities being hedged will not move to the same extent as do the prices of its put options on the stock indices. It is also possible that, if a Fund has hedged against the possibility of a decline in the market adversely affecting securities held in its portfolio and securities prices increase instead, a Fund will lose part or all of the benefit of the increased values of those securities that it has hedged, because it will have offsetting losses in its futures positions. In addition, in such situations, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell securities to meet daily variation margin requirements.

In addition to the possibility that there may be an imperfect correlation, or no correlation at all, between movements in the index futures and the securities of the portfolio being hedged, the prices of index futures may not correlate perfectly with movements in the underlying index due to certain market distortions. First, all participants in the futures markets are subject to margin deposit and maintenance requirements. Rather than meeting additional margin deposit requirements, investors may close futures contracts through offsetting transactions, which would distort the normal relationship between the index and futures markets. Second, margin requirements in the futures market are less onerous than margin requirements in the securities market, and as a result, the futures market may attract more speculators than the securities market. Increased participation by speculators in the futures market may also cause temporary price distortions. Due to the possibility of price distortions in the futures market, and also because of the imperfect correlation between movements in an index and movements in the prices of index futures, even a correct forecast of general market trends by the Adviser may still not result in a successful hedging transaction.

 

28


Table of Contents

 

There is also the risk of loss by a Fund of margin deposits in the event of bankruptcy of a broker with whom a Fund has an open position in a futures contract or related option. Most futures exchanges limit the amount of fluctuation permitted in some contract prices during a single trading day. The daily limit establishes the maximum amount that the price of a futures contract may vary either up or down from the previous day’s settlement price at the end of a trading session. Once the daily limit has been reached in a particular type of contract, no trades may be made on that day at a price beyond that limit. The daily limit governs only price movement during a particular trading day and, therefore, does not limit potential losses, because the limit may prevent the liquidation of unfavorable positions. Futures contract prices have occasionally moved to the daily limit for several consecutive trading days with little or no trading, thereby preventing prompt liquidation of futures positions and subjecting some futures traders to substantial losses.

Options on Index Futures Contracts. A Fund may also purchase and sell options on index futures contracts. Options on index futures give the purchaser the right, in return for the premium paid, to assume a position in an index futures contract (a long position if the option is a call and a short position if the option is a put), at a specified exercise price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise of the option, the delivery of the futures position by the writer of the option to the holder of the option will be accompanied by delivery of the accumulated balance in the writer’s futures margin account, which represents the amount by which the market price of the index futures contract, at exercise, exceeds (in the case of a call) or is less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option on the index future. If an option is exercised on the last trading day prior to the expiration date of the option, the settlement will be made entirely in cash equal to the difference between the exercise price of the option and the closing level of the index on which the future is based on the expiration date. Purchasers of options who fail to exercise their options prior to the exercise date suffer a loss of the premium paid.

There are various risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. For example, a risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged; there can be no assurance that the Adviser will be successful in doing so.

Use by Tax-Exempt Funds of Interest Rate and U.S. Treasury Security Futures Contracts and Options. If a Fund invests in tax-exempt securities, it may purchase and sell futures contracts and related options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities when, in the opinion of the Adviser, price movements in these security futures and related options will correlate closely with price movements in the tax-exempt securities which are the subject of the hedge. Interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities futures contracts require the seller to deliver, or the purchaser to take delivery of, the type of security called for in the contract at a specified date and price. Options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts give the purchaser the right in return for the premium paid to assume a position in a futures contract at the specified option exercise price at any time during the period of the option.

In addition to the risks generally involved in using futures contracts, there is also a risk that price movements in interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts and related options will not correlate closely with price movements in markets for tax-exempt securities.

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

A Fund may purchase and write (i.e., sell) put and call options. Such options may relate to particular stocks or stock indices, and may or may not be listed on a domestic or foreign securities exchange and may or may not be issued by the Options Clearing Corporation (OCC). Stock index options are put options and call options on various stock indices. In most respects, they are identical to listed options on common stocks.

 

29


Table of Contents

 

There is a key difference between stock options and stock index options in connection with their exercise. In the case of stock options, the underlying security, common stock, is delivered. However, upon the exercise of an index option, settlement does not occur by delivery of the securities comprising the index. The option holder who exercises the index option receives an amount of cash if the closing level of the stock index upon which the option is based is greater than (in the case of a call) or less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option. This amount of cash is equal to the difference between the closing price of the stock index and the exercise price of the option expressed in dollars times a specified multiple. A stock index fluctuates with changes in the market value of the securities included in the index. For example, some stock index options are based on a broad market index, such as the S&P 500® Index or a narrower market index, such as the S&P 100® Index. Indices may also be based on an industry or market segment.

The successful use of a Fund’s options strategies depends on the ability of the Adviser to forecast interest rate and market movements correctly. When it purchases an option, a Fund runs the risk that it will lose its entire investment in the option in a relatively short period of time, unless a Fund exercises the option or enters into a closing sale transaction for such option during the life of the option. If the price of the underlying security does not rise (in the case of a call) or fall (in the case of a put) to an extent sufficient to cover the option premium and transaction costs, a Fund will lose part or all of its investment in the option. This contrasts with an investment by a Fund in the underlying securities, since a Fund may continue to hold its investment in those securities notwithstanding the lack of a change in price of those securities.

The effective use of options also depends on a Fund’s ability to terminate option positions at times when the Adviser deems it desirable to do so. Although a Fund will take an option position only if the Adviser believes there is a liquid secondary market for the option, there is no assurance that a Fund will be able to effect closing transactions at any particular time or at an acceptable price.

If a secondary trading market in options were to become unavailable, a Fund could no longer engage in closing transactions. The writer in such circumstances would be subject to the risk of market decline or appreciation in the instrument during such period. If an option purchased by a Fund expires unexercised, a Fund will realize a loss equal to the premium paid. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain options; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions or closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of options, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series of options), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of options) would cease to exist, although outstanding options on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying options purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on the options. If trading is interrupted in an underlying security, the trading of options on that security is normally halted as well. As a result, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be unable to close out its positions until options trading resumes, and it may be faced with losses if trading in the security reopens at a substantially different price. In addition, the OCC or other options markets may impose exercise restrictions. If a prohibition on exercise is imposed at a time when trading in the option has also been halted, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be locked into its position until one of the two restrictions has been lifted. If a prohibition on exercise remains in effect until an option owned by a Fund has expired, a Fund could lose the entire value of its option.

 

30


Table of Contents

 

Special risks are presented by internationally traded options. Because of time differences between the United States and various foreign countries, and because different holidays are observed in different countries, foreign options markets may be open for trading during hours or on days when U.S. markets are closed. As a result, option premiums may not reflect the current prices of the underlying interest in the United States.

Dealer (Over-the-Counter) Options. Dealer options are options negotiated individually through dealers rather than traded on an exchange. Certain risks are specific to dealer options. While a Fund might look to a clearing corporation to exercise exchange-traded options, if a Fund purchases a dealer option it must rely on the selling dealer to perform if a Fund exercises the option. Failure by the dealer to do so would result in the loss of the premium paid by a Fund as well as loss of the expected benefit of the transaction. Exchange-traded options generally have a continuous liquid market while dealer options more often may not. Consequently, a Fund can realize the value of a dealer option it has purchased only by exercising or reselling the option to the issuing dealer. Similarly, when a Fund writes a dealer option, a Fund can close out the option prior to its expiration only by entering into a closing purchase transaction with the dealer. While each Fund seeks to enter into dealer options only with dealers who will agree to and can enter into closing transactions with a Fund, no assurance exists that a Fund will at any time be able to liquidate a dealer option at a favorable price at any time prior to expiration. Unless a Fund, as a covered dealer call option writer, can effect a closing purchase transaction, it will not be able to liquidate securities (or other assets) used as cover until the option expires or is exercised. In the event of insolvency of the other party, a Fund may be unable to liquidate a dealer option. With respect to options written by a Fund, the inability to enter into a closing transaction may result in material losses to a Fund. For example, because a Fund must maintain a secured position with respect to any call option on a security it writes, a Fund may not sell the assets, that it has segregated to secure the position while it is obligated under the option. This requirement may impair a Fund’s ability to sell portfolio securities at a time when such sale might be advantageous.

A Fund generally will treat purchased dealer options as illiquid securities. A Fund may treat the cover used for written dealer options as liquid if the dealer agrees that a Fund may repurchase the dealer option it has written for a maximum price to be calculated by a predetermined formula. In such cases, the dealer option would be considered illiquid only to the extent the maximum purchase price under the formula exceeds the intrinsic value of the option.

Writing Covered Options. A Fund may write covered call options and covered put options on securities held in its portfolio when, in the opinion of the Adviser, such transactions are consistent with a Fund’s investment goal and policies. Call options written by a Fund give the purchaser the right to buy the underlying securities from a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price; put options give the purchaser the right to sell the underlying securities to a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price.

A Fund may write only covered options, which means that, so long as a Fund is obligated as the writer of a call option, it will own the underlying securities subject to the option (or comparable securities satisfying the cover requirements of securities exchanges). In the case of put options, a Fund will hold cash and/or high-grade short-term debt obligations equal to the price to be paid if the option is exercised. In addition, a Fund will be considered to have covered a put or call option if and to the extent that it holds an option that offsets some or all of the risk of the option it has written. A Fund may write combinations of covered puts and calls (straddles) on the same underlying security.

A Fund will receive a premium from writing a put or call option, which increases a Fund’s return on the underlying security if the option expires unexercised or is closed out at a profit. The amount of the premium reflects, among other things, the relationship between the exercise price and the current market value of the underlying security, the volatility of the underlying security, the amount of time remaining until expiration, current interest rates, and the effect of supply and demand in the options market and in the market for the

 

31


Table of Contents

underlying security. By writing a call option, a Fund limits its opportunity to profit from any increase in the market value of the underlying security above the exercise price of the option but continues to bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security. By writing a put option, a Fund assumes the risk that it may be required to purchase the underlying security for an exercise price higher than the security’s then-current market value, resulting in a potential capital loss unless the security subsequently appreciates in value.

A Fund’s obligation to sell an instrument subject to a call option written by it, or to purchase an instrument subject to a put option written by it, may be terminated prior to the expiration date of the option by a Fund’s execution of a closing purchase transaction, which is effected by purchasing on an exchange an offsetting option of the same series (i.e., same underlying instrument, exercise price and expiration date) as the option previously written. A closing purchase transaction will ordinarily be effected in order to realize a profit on an outstanding option, to prevent an underlying instrument from being called, to permit the sale of the underlying instrument or to permit the writing of a new option containing different terms on such underlying instrument. A Fund realizes a profit or loss from a closing purchase transaction if the cost of the transaction (option premium plus transaction costs) is less or more than the premium received from writing the option. Because increases in the market price of a call option generally reflect increases in the market price of the security underlying the option, any loss resulting from a closing purchase transaction may be offset in whole or in part by unrealized appreciation of the underlying security.

If a Fund writes a call option but does not own the underlying security, and when it writes a put option, a Fund may be required to deposit cash or securities with its broker as “margin” or collateral for its obligation to buy or sell the underlying security. As the value of the underlying security varies, a Fund may also have to deposit additional margin with the broker. Margin requirements are complex and are fixed by individual brokers, subject to minimum requirements currently imposed by the Federal Reserve Board and by stock exchanges and other self-regulatory organizations.

Purchasing Put Options. A Fund may purchase put options to protect its portfolio holdings in an underlying security against a decline in market value. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the put option since a Fund, as holder of the put option, is able to sell the underlying security at the put exercise price regardless of any decline in the underlying security’s market price. For a put option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must decline sufficiently below the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. By using put options in this manner, a Fund will reduce any profit it might otherwise have realized from appreciation of the underlying security by the premium paid for the put option and by transaction costs.

Purchasing Call Options. A Fund may purchase call options to hedge against an increase in the price of securities that a Fund wants ultimately to buy. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the call option since a Fund, as holder of the call option, is able to buy the underlying security at the exercise price regardless of any increase in the underlying security’s market price. In order for a call option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must rise sufficiently above the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. These costs will reduce any profit a Fund might have realized had it bought the underlying security at the time it purchased the call option.

Over-the-Counter (OTC) Options. A Fund will enter into OTC options transactions only with primary dealers in U.S. Government securities and, in the case of OTC options written by a Fund, only pursuant to agreements that will assure that a Fund will at all times have the right to repurchase the option written by it from the dealer at a specified formula price. A Fund will treat the amount by which such formula price exceeds the amount, if any, by which the option may be “in-the-money” as an illiquid investment. It is the present policy of a Fund not to enter into any OTC option transaction if, as a result, more than 15% (10% in some cases, refer to your Fund’s prospectuses) of a Fund’s net assets would be invested in (i) illiquid investments (determined under the foregoing formula) relating to OTC options written by a Fund, (ii) OTC options purchased by a Fund, (iii) securities which are not readily marketable, and (iv) repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days.

 

32


Table of Contents

 

Index Options. As an alternative to purchasing call and put options on index futures, a Fund may purchase call and put options on the underlying indices themselves. Such options could be used in a manner identical to the use of options on index futures. Options involving securities indices provide the holder with the right to make or receive a cash settlement upon exercise of the option based on movements in the relevant index. Such options must be listed on a national securities exchange and issued by the OCC. Such options may relate to particular securities or to various stock indices, except that a Fund may not write covered options on an index.

Foreign Stock Index Options. A Fund may, for the purpose of hedging its portfolio, subject to applicable securities regulations, purchase and write put and call options on foreign stock indices listed on foreign and domestic stock exchanges.

Swap Agreements

Swap agreements are derivative instruments that can be individually negotiated and structured to include exposure to a variety of different types of investments or market factors. Depending on their structure, swap agreements may increase or decrease a Fund’s exposure to long- or short-term interest rates, foreign currency values, mortgage securities, corporate borrowing rates, or other factors such as security prices or inflation rates. A Fund may enter into a variety of swap agreements, including interest rate, index, commodity, equity, credit default and currency exchange rate swap agreements, and other types of swap agreements such as caps, collars and floors. A Fund also may enter into swaptions, which are options to enter into a swap agreement.

In a typical interest rate swap, one party agrees to make regular payments equal to a floating interest rate times a “notional principal amount,” in return for payments equal to a fixed rate times the same amount, for a specified period of time. If a swap agreement provides for payments in different currencies, the parties might agree to exchange notional principal amount as well. In a total return swap agreement, the non-floating rate side of the swap is based on the total return of an individual security, a basket of securities, an index or another reference asset. Swaps may also depend on other prices or rates, such as the value of an index or mortgage prepayment rates.

In a typical cap or floor agreement, one party agrees to make payments only under specified circumstances, usually in return for payment of a fee by the other party. For example, the buyer of an interest rate cap obtains the right to receive payments to the extent that a specified interest rate exceeds an agreed-upon level, while the seller of an interest rate floor is obligated to make payments to the extent that a specified interest rate falls below an agreed-upon level. Caps and floors have an effect similar to buying or writing options. A collar combines elements of buying a cap and selling a floor.

Swap agreements will tend to shift a Fund’s investment exposure from one type of investment to another. For example, if a Fund agreed to pay fixed rates in exchange for floating rates while holding fixed-rate bonds, the swap would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to long-term interest rates. Another example is if a Fund agreed to exchange payments in dollars for payments in foreign currency, the swap agreement would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to U.S. interest rates and increase its exposure to foreign currency and interest rates.

Swap agreements are sophisticated hedging instruments that typically involve a small investment of cash relative to the magnitude of risks assumed. As a result, swaps can be highly volatile and may have a considerable impact on a Fund’s performance. Depending on how they are used, swap agreements may increase or decrease the overall volatility of a Fund’s investments and its share price and yield. Additionally, whether a Fund’s use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment objective will depend on the Adviser’s ability correctly to predict whether certain types of investments likely are to produce greater returns than other investments. Because they are two party contracts and because they may have terms of greater than seven days, swap agreements may be considered to be illiquid. Moreover, a Fund bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. The most significant factor in the performance of swap agreements is the change in the specific

 

33


Table of Contents

interest rate, currency, or other factor that determines the amounts of payments due to and from a Fund. If a swap agreement calls for payments by a Fund, a Fund must be prepared to make such payments when due. In addition, if the counterparty’s creditworthiness declines, the value of a swap agreement likely would decline, potentially resulting in losses for a Fund. A Fund will closely monitor the credit of a swap agreement counterparty in order to attempt to minimize this risk. A Fund may also suffer losses if it is unable to terminate outstanding swap agreements (either by assignment or other disposition) or reduce its exposure through offsetting transactions (i.e., by entering into an offsetting swap agreement with the same party or a similarly creditworthy party).

Credit Default Swap Agreements. A Fund may enter into credit default swap agreements, which may have as reference obligations one or more securities or a basket of securities that are or are not currently held by a Fund. The protection “buyer” in a credit default contract is generally obligated to pay the protection “seller” an upfront or a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract provided that no credit event, such as a default, on a reference obligation has occurred. If a credit event occurs, the seller generally must pay the buyer the “par value” (full notional value) of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity described in the swap, or the seller may be required to deliver the related net cash amount, if the swap is cash settled. A Fund may be either the buyer or seller in the transaction. If a Fund is a buyer and no credit event occurs, a Fund may recover nothing if the swap is held through its termination date. However, if a credit event occurs, the buyer generally may elect to receive the full notional value of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity whose value may have significantly decreased. As a seller, a Fund generally receives an upfront payment or a fixed rate of income throughout the term of the swap provided that there is no credit event. As the seller, a Fund would effectively add leverage to its portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Credit default swap agreements may involve greater risks than if a Fund had invested in the reference obligation directly since, in addition to risks relating to the reference obligation, credit default swaps are subject to illiquidity risk, counterparty risk and credit risk. A Fund will enter into credit default swap agreements generally with counterparties that meet certain standards of creditworthiness. A buyer generally will lose its investment and recover nothing if no credit event occurs and the swap is held to its termination date. If a credit event were to occur, the value of any deliverable obligation received by the seller, coupled with the upfront or periodic payments previously received, may be less than the full notional value it pays to the buyer, resulting in a loss of value to the seller.

Equity Swaps. A Fund may engage in equity swaps. Equity swaps allow the parties to the swap agreement to exchange components of return on one equity investment (e.g., a basket of equity securities or an index) for a component of return on another non-equity or equity investment, including an exchange of differential rates of return. Equity swaps may be used to invest in a market without owning or taking physical custody of securities in circumstances where direct investment may be restricted for legal reasons or is otherwise impractical. Equity swaps also may be used for other purposes, such as hedging or seeking to increase total return.

The values of equity swaps can be very volatile. To the extent that the Adviser does not accurately analyze and predict the potential relative fluctuation on the components swapped with the other party, a Fund may suffer a loss. The value of some components of an equity swap (such as the dividend on a common stock) may also be sensitive to changes in interest rates. Furthermore, during the period a swap is outstanding, a Fund may suffer a loss if the counterparty defaults.

Total Return Swap Agreements. Total return swap agreements are contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in market value of the assets underlying the contract, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or securities indices during the specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate or the total return from other underlying assets. Total return swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Total return swap

 

34


Table of Contents

agreements may effectively add leverage to a Fund’s portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Total return swap agreements are subject to the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations to a Fund thereunder, and conversely, that a Fund will not be able to meet its obligation to the counterparty. Generally, a Fund will enter into total return swaps on a net basis (i.e., the two payment streams are netted against one another with a Fund receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments). The net amount of the excess, if any, of a Fund’s obligations over its entitlements with respect to each total return swap will be accrued on a daily basis, and an amount of liquid assets having an aggregate net asset value at least equal to the accrued excess will be segregated by a Fund. If the total return swap transaction is entered into on other than a net basis, the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be accrued on a daily basis, and the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be segregated by a Fund in an amount equal to or greater than the market value of the liabilities under the total return swap agreement or the amount it would have cost a Fund initially to make an equivalent direct investment, plus or minus any amount a Fund is obligated to pay or is to receive under the total return swap agreement.

Variance, Volatility and Correlation Swap Agreements. Variance and volatility swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the volatility of certain referenced assets. Correlation swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the correlation between the prices of different assets or different market rates.

Dollar Rolls

Dollar rolls involve selling securities (e.g., mortgage-backed securities or U.S. Treasury securities) and simultaneously entering into a commitment to purchase those or similar (same collateral type, coupon and maturity) securities on a specified future date and price. Mortgage dollar rolls and U.S. Treasury rolls are types of dollar rolls. A Fund foregoes principal and interest paid on the securities during the “roll” period. A Fund is compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the lower forward price for the future purchase of the securities as well as the interest earned on the cash proceeds of the initial sale.

Dollar rolls involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase may decline below the repurchase price or that the transaction costs may exceed the return earned by a Fund from the transaction. Dollar rolls also involve risk to a Fund if the other party should default on its obligation and a Fund is delayed or prevented from completing the transaction. In the event that the buyer of securities under a dollar roll files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the dollar roll may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, the security to be delivered in the future may turn out to be inferior to the security sold upon entering into the transaction.

Foreign Currency Transactions

Foreign currency transactions may be used to protect, to some extent, against uncertainty in the level of future currency exchange rates by establishing a fixed exchange rate. Foreign currency transactions may involve the purchase or sale of foreign currencies on a “spot” (cash) basis at the prevailing exchange rate or may involve “forward contracts” that allow a Fund to purchase or sell foreign currencies at a future date. Forward contracts may be used for “transaction hedging,” “position hedging” and “cross-hedging.” A Fund may use forward sale contracts to sell an amount of a foreign currency approximating the value of a Fund’s securities denominated in the foreign security when that foreign currency suffers a substantial decline against the U.S. dollar. A Fund may use forward purchase contracts to purchase a foreign currency when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a substantial decline against the foreign currency. Although these transactions tend to minimize the risk of loss due to a decline in the value of the hedged currency, they also tend to limit any potential gain that might be realized if the value of the hedged currency increases.

 

35


Table of Contents

 

Transaction hedging may allow a Fund to “lock in” the U.S. dollar price of a security it has agreed to purchase or sell, or the U.S. dollar equivalent of a dividend or interest rate payment in a foreign currency. A Fund may use transaction hedging to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currency during the period between the date on which the security is purchased or sold, or on which the dividend or interest payment is declared, and the date on which such payments are made or received.

Position hedging may allow a Fund to protect against an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currencies in which its portfolio securities are denominated. A Fund may use position hedging when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a decline against the foreign currency by entering into a forward purchase contract to purchase that foreign currency for a fixed dollar amount.

Cross-hedging may allow a Fund to enter into a forward contract to sell a different foreign currency for a fixed U.S. dollar amount when it is believed that the U.S. dollar value of the currency to be sold pursuant to the forward contract will fall if there is a decline in the U.S. dollar value of the currency in which a Fund’s securities are denominated.

A Fund also may purchase exchange-listed and over-the-counter call and put options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts. Options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts give the holder a right to buy or sell the underlying foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts for a specified period of time and for a specified amount. The value of an option on foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts reflects the value of an exchange rate, which depends on the relative values of the U.S. dollar and the relevant foreign currency.

Engaging in foreign currency transactions is subject to certain risks. For example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the dollar value of any securities held by a Fund denominated in that currency. It is impossible to forecast with precision the market value of portfolio securities at the expiration or maturity of a forward or futures contract, which may make it necessary for a Fund to purchase additional foreign currency on the spot market if the market value of the security being hedged is less than the amount of foreign currency a Fund is obligated to deliver at the time a Fund sells the security being hedged. The value of any currency, including the U.S. dollar, may be affected by political and economic factors applicable to the issuer’s country. The exchange rates of currencies also may be affected adversely by governmental actions. Transaction, position and cross-hedging do not eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of securities that a Fund owns or intends to purchase or sell and may limit the amount of potential gain that might result from the increase in value of the currency being hedged. Settlement procedures relating to a Fund’s foreign currency transactions may be more complex than those relating to investments in securities of U.S. issuers.

Foreign Securities

Foreign securities include debt, equity and derivative securities that the Adviser determines are “foreign” based on the consideration of an issuer’s domicile, its principal place of business, its primary stock exchange listing, the source of its revenue or other factors. Foreign securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Foreign securities may include depositary receipts, such as American Depositary Receipts (ADRs), European Depositary Receipts (EDRs) and Global Depositary Receipts (GDRs). ADRs are U.S. dollar denominated receipts issued in registered form by a domestic bank or trust company that evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by a foreign issuer. EDRs are foreign currency-denominated receipts issued in

 

36


Table of Contents

Europe, typically by foreign banks or trust companies and foreign branches of domestic banks, that evidence ownership of foreign or domestic securities. GDRs are receipts structured similarly to ADRs and EDRs and are marketed globally. Depositary receipts will not necessarily be denominated in the same currency as their underlying securities. In general, ADRs, in registered form, are designed for use in the U.S. securities markets, and EDRs, in bearer form, are designed for use in European securities markets. GDRs are tradable both in the United States and in Europe and are designed for use throughout the world. A Fund may invest in depositary receipts through “sponsored” or “unsponsored” facilities. A sponsored facility is established jointly by the issuer of the underlying security and a depositary, whereas a depositary may establish an unsponsored facility without participation by the issuer of the deposited security. Holders of unsponsored depositary receipts generally bear all the costs of such facilities and the depositary of an unsponsored facility frequently is under no obligation to distribute interest holder communications received from the issuer of the deposited security or to pass through voting rights to the holders of such receipts in respect of the deposited securities. The issuers of unsponsored depositary receipts are not obligated to disclose material information in the United States, and, therefore, there may be limited information available regarding such issuers and/or limited correlation between available information and the market value of the depositary receipts.

Due to the potential for foreign withholding taxes, Morgan Stanley Capital International (MSCI) publishes two versions of its indices reflecting the reinvestment of dividends using two different methodologies: gross dividends and net dividends. While both versions reflect reinvested dividends, they differ with respect to the manner in which taxes associated with dividend payments are treated. In calculating the net dividends version, MSCI incorporates reinvested dividends applying the withholding tax rate applicable to foreign non-resident institutional investors that do not benefit from double taxation treaties. The Adviser believes that the net dividends version of MSCI indices better reflects the returns U.S. investors might expect were they to invest directly in the component securities of an MSCI index.

Investing in foreign securities is subject to certain risks. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates also may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies or U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Additionally, the U.S. dollar value of a foreign security tends to decrease when the value of the U.S. dollar rises against the foreign currency in which the security is denominated and tends to increase when the value of the U.S. dollar falls against such currency. A Fund may attempt to minimize the risk from adverse changes in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies by purchasing and selling forward foreign currency exchange contracts and foreign currency futures contracts and related options. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that a Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees also are generally higher for foreign securities. A Fund may have limited legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain debt securities issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which would reduce a Fund’s return on these securities.

Other risks of investing in foreign securities include: possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the notification of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; adverse impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and that foreign companies generally are not subject to accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards comparable to those mandated for domestic companies.

Risks associated with investments in foreign securities are increased with respect to investments in emerging market countries. Political and economic structures in many emerging market countries, especially those in Eastern Europe, the Pacific Basin and the Far East, are undergoing significant evolutionary changes and rapid development, and may lack the social, political and economic stability of more developed countries. Investing in emerging market securities also involves risks beyond the risks applicable to foreign investments. For example, some emerging market countries may have fixed or managed currencies that are not free-floating against the U.S. dollar. Further, certain currencies may not be traded internationally, and some countries with

 

37


Table of Contents

emerging securities markets have sustained long periods of very high inflation or rapid fluctuation in inflation rates which can have negative effects on a country’s economy and securities markets.

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Agreements)

Guaranteed investment contracts, or funding agreements, are debt instruments issued by insurance companies. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of the insurance company’s general account. The insurance company then credits to a Fund payments at negotiated, floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund will purchase guaranteed investment contracts only from issuers that, at the time of purchase, meet certain credit and quality standards.

Investing in guaranteed investment contracts is subject to certain risks. In general, guaranteed investment contracts are not assignable or transferable without the permission of the issuing insurance companies, and an active secondary market does not exist for these investments. In addition, the issuer may not be able to pay the principal amount to a Fund on seven days notice or less, at which time the investment may be considered illiquid under applicable SEC regulatory guidance and subject to certain restrictions.

Illiquid Securities

Illiquid securities are defined by a Fund consistent with SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is an asset which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which a Fund has valued the investment on its books. Some securities, such as those not registered under U.S. securities laws, cannot be sold in public transactions. Subject to its investment policies, a Fund may invest in illiquid investments and may invest in certain restricted securities that are deemed to be illiquid securities.

Initial Public Offerings

A Fund may invest in initial public offerings (IPOs) of common stock or other primary or secondary syndicated offerings of equity or debt securities issued by a corporate issuer. Fixed income funds frequently invest in these types of offerings of debt securities. A purchase of IPO securities often involves higher transaction costs than those associated with the purchase of securities already traded on exchanges or markets. IPO securities are subject to market risk and liquidity risk. The market value of recently issued IPO securities may fluctuate considerably due to factors such as the absence of a prior public market, unseasoned trading and speculation, a potentially small number of securities available for trading, limited information about the issuer, and other factors. A Fund may hold IPO securities for a period of time, or may sell them soon after the purchase. Investments in IPOs could have a magnified impact – either positive or negative – on a Fund’s performance while the Fund’s assets are relatively small. The impact of an IPO on a Fund’s performance may tend to diminish as the Fund’s assets grow. In circumstances when investments in IPOs make a significant contribution to a Fund’s performance, there can be no assurance that similar contributions from IPOs will continue in the future.

Investments in Other Investment Companies

Investing in other investment companies may be a means by which a Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective. A Fund may invest in securities issued by other investment companies within the limits prescribed by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive orders currently or in the future obtained by a Fund from the SEC.

Except with respect to funds structured as funds-of-funds or so-called master/feeder funds, the 1940 Act generally requires that a fund limit its investments in another investment company or series thereof so that, as determined at the time a securities purchase is made: (i) no more than 5% of the value of its total assets will be invested in the securities of any one investment company; (ii) no more than 10% of the value of its total assets

 

38


Table of Contents

will be invested in the aggregate in securities of other investment companies; and (iii) no more than 3% of the outstanding voting stock of any one investment company or series thereof will be owned by a fund or by companies controlled by a fund. Such other investment companies may include ETFs, which are shares of publicly traded unit investment trusts, open-end funds or depositary receipts that seek to track the performance of specific indexes or companies in related industries.

Investing in other investment companies is subject to certain risks. Although a Fund may derive certain advantages from being able to invest in shares of other investment companies, such as to be fully invested, there may be potential disadvantages. Investing in other investment companies may result in higher fees and expenses for a Fund and its shareholders. A shareholder may be charged fees not only on Fund shares held directly but also on the investment company shares that a Fund purchases.

In addition, investing in ETFs is subject to certain other risks. ETFs generally are subject to the same risks as the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track as well as to the risks of the specific sector or industry to which the ETF relates. ETFs also are subject to the risk that their prices may not totally correlate to the prices of the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track and the risk of possible trading halts due to market conditions or for other reasons.

Under the 1940 Act and rules and regulations thereunder, a Fund may purchase shares of affiliated funds, subject to certain conditions. Investing in affiliated funds may present certain actual or potential conflicts of interest. For more information about such actual and potential conflicts of interest, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

Low and below investment grade securities (below investment grade securities are also known as “junk bonds”) are debt securities with the lowest investment grade rating (e.g., BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by Moody’s), that are below investment grade (e.g., lower than BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by Moody’s) or that are unrated but determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality. These types of securities may be issued to fund corporate transactions or restructurings, such as leveraged buyouts, mergers, acquisitions, debt reclassifications or similar events, are more speculative in nature than securities with higher ratings and tend to be more sensitive to credit risk, particularly during a downturn in the economy. These types of securities generally are issued by unseasoned companies without long track records of sales and earnings, or by companies or municipalities that have questionable credit strength. Low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities: (i) likely will have some quality and protective characteristics that, in the judgment of one or more NRSROs, are outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions; (ii) are speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation; and (iii) may have a less liquid secondary market, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities. Low and below investment grade securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities is subject to certain risks. The rates of return on these types of securities generally are higher than the rates of return available on more highly rated securities, but generally involve greater volatility of price and risk of loss of principal and income, including the possibility of default by or insolvency of the issuers of such securities. Accordingly, a Fund may be more dependent on the Adviser’s credit analysis with respect to these types of securities than is the case for more highly rated securities.

 

39


Table of Contents

 

The market values of certain low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities tend to be more sensitive to individual corporate developments and changes in economic conditions than are the market value of more highly rated securities. In addition, issuers of low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities often are highly leveraged and may not have more traditional methods of financing available to them, so that their ability to service their debt obligations during an economic downturn or during sustained periods of rising interest rates may be impaired.

The risk of loss due to default is greater for low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities than it is for higher rated securities because low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities generally are unsecured and frequently are subordinated to more senior indebtedness. A Fund may incur additional expenses to the extent that it is required to seek recovery upon a default in the payment of principal or interest on its holdings of such securities. The existence of limited markets for lower-rated debt securities may diminish a Fund’s ability to: (i) obtain accurate market quotations for purposes of valuing such securities and calculating portfolio net asset value; and (ii) sell the securities at fair market value either to meet redemption requests or to respond to changes in the economy or in financial markets.

Many lower-rated securities are not registered for offer and sale to the public under the 1933Act. Investments in these restricted securities may be determined to be liquid (able to be sold within seven days at approximately the price at which they are valued by a Fund) pursuant to policies approved by the Fund’s Trustees. Investments in illiquid securities, including restricted securities that have not been determined to be liquid, may not exceed 15% of a Fund’s net assets. A Fund is not otherwise subject to any limitation on its ability to invest in restricted securities. Restricted securities may be less liquid than other lower-rated securities, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities.

Money Market Instruments

Money market instruments are high-quality, short-term debt obligations, which include: (i) bank obligations, including certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers’ acceptances; (ii) funding agreements; (iii) repurchase agreements; (iv) obligations of the United States, foreign countries and supranational entities, and each of their subdivisions, agencies and instrumentalities; (v) certain corporate debt securities, such as commercial paper, short-term corporate obligations and extendible commercial notes; (vi) participation interests; and (vii) municipal securities. Money market instruments may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in money market instruments is subject to certain risks. Money market instruments (other than certain U.S. Government obligations) are not backed or insured by the U.S. Government, its agencies or its instrumentalities. Accordingly, only the creditworthiness of an issuer, or guarantees of that issuer, support such instruments.

Mortgage-Backed Securities

Mortgage-backed securities are a type of asset-backed security and represent interests in, or debt instruments backed by, pools of underlying mortgages. In some cases, these underlying mortgages may be insured or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Mortgage-backed securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral (less fees paid to the originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral effectively pass through to such security holders. Mortgage-backed securities are created when mortgage originators (or mortgage loan sellers who have purchased mortgage loans from mortgage loan originators) sell the underlying mortgages to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying

 

40


Table of Contents

mortgage loans, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Mortgage-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Mortgage-backed securities may be issued or guaranteed by GNMA (also known as Ginnie Mae), FNMA (also known as Fannie Mae), or FHLMC (also known as Freddie Mac), but also may be issued or guaranteed by other issuers, including private companies. GNMA is a government-owned corporation that is an agency of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. It guarantees, with the full faith and credit of the United States, full and timely payment of all monthly principal and interest on its mortgage-backed securities. Until recently, FNMA and FHLMC were government-sponsored corporations owned entirely by private stockholders. Both issue mortgage-related securities that contain guarantees as to timely payment of interest and principal but that are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. The value of the companies’ securities fell sharply in 2008 due to concerns that the firms did not have sufficient capital to offset losses. In mid-2008, the U.S. Treasury was authorized to increase the size of home loans that FNMA and FHLMC could purchase in certain residential areas and, until 2009, to lend FNMA and FHLMC emergency funds and to purchase the companies’ stock. In September 2008, the U.S. Treasury announced that FNMA and FHLMC had been placed in conservatorship by the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), a newly created independent regulator. In addition to placing the companies in conservatorship, the U.S. Treasury announced three additional steps that it intended to take with respect to FNMA and FHLMC. First, the U.S. Treasury has entered into “Preferred Stock Purchase Agreements” (PSPAs) under which, if the FHFA determines that FNMA’s or FHLMC’s liabilities have exceeded its assets under generally accepted accounting principles, the U.S. Treasury will contribute cash capital to the company in an amount equal to the difference between liabilities and assets. The PSPAs are designed to provide protection to the senior and subordinated debt and the mortgage-backed securities issued by FNMA and FHLMC. Second, the U.S. Treasury established a new secured lending credit facility that was available to FNMA and FHLMC until December 2009. Third, the U.S. Treasury initiated a temporary program to purchase FNMA and FHLMC mortgage-backed securities that concluded in December 2009. Although the U.S. Government has provided support to FNMA and FHLMC, there can be no assurances that it will support these and other government sponsored enterprises in the future.

CMOs are debt obligations issued by special-purpose trusts, collateralized by underlying mortgage assets. Principal prepayments on underlying mortgage assets may cause the CMOs to be retired substantially earlier than their stated maturities or final distribution dates, resulting in a loss of all or part of the premium if any has been paid. Interest is paid or accrues on all classes of the CMOs on a periodic basis. The principal and interest payments on the underlying mortgage assets may be allocated among the various classes of CMOs in several ways. Typically, payments of principal, including any prepayments, on the underlying mortgage assets are applied to the classes in the order of their respective stated maturities or final distribution dates, so that no payment of principal is made on CMOs of a class until all CMOs of other classes having earlier stated maturities or final distribution dates have been paid in full.

REMICs are entities that own mortgages and elect REMIC status under the Code and, like CMOs, issue debt obligations collateralized by underlying mortgage assets that have characteristics similar to those issued by CMOs.

Investing in mortgage-backed securities is subject to certain risks, including, among others, prepayment, market and credit risks. Prepayment risk reflects the risk that borrowers may prepay their mortgages more quickly than expected, which may affect the security’s average maturity and rate of return. Whether or not a mortgage loan is prepaid is almost entirely controlled by the borrower. Borrowers are most likely to exercise prepayment options at the time when it is least advantageous to investors, generally prepaying mortgages as interest rates fall, and slowing payments as interest rates rise. Besides the effect of prevailing interest rates, the

 

41


Table of Contents

rate of prepayment and refinancing of mortgages also may be affected by home value appreciation, ease of the refinancing process and local economic conditions, among other factors. Market risk reflects the risk that the price of a security may fluctuate over time. The price of mortgage-backed securities can be particularly sensitive to prevailing interest rates, the length of time the security is expected to be outstanding and the liquidity of the issue. In a period of unstable interest rates, there may be decreased demand for certain types of mortgage-backed securities, which in turn may decrease their value. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of mortgage-backed securities may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or the underlying mortgage borrower has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for mortgage-backed securities that are backed by mortgages to so-called subprime borrowers (who may pose a greater risk of defaulting on their loans) or that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of a mortgage-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be. Mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers, whether or not such obligations are subject to guarantees by the private issuer, may entail greater risk than mortgage-backed securities guaranteed by the U.S. Government. The performance of mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers generally depends on the financial health of those institutions.

Municipal Securities

Municipal securities include debt obligations issued by governmental entities to obtain funds for various public purposes, including the construction of a wide range of public facilities, the refunding of outstanding obligations, the payment of general operating expenses, and the extension of loans to public institutions and facilities. Municipal securities can be classified into two principal categories, including “general obligation” bonds and other securities and “revenue” bonds and other securities. General obligation bonds are secured by the issuer’s full faith, credit and taxing power for the payment of principal and interest. Revenue securities are payable only from the revenues derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue source, such as the user of the facility being financed. Municipal securities also may include “moral obligation” securities, which normally are issued by special purpose public authorities. If the issuer of moral obligation securities is unable to meet its debt service obligations from current revenues, it may draw on a reserve fund, the restoration of which is a moral commitment but not a legal obligation of the governmental entity that created the special purpose public authority. Municipal securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Municipal securities may include municipal bonds, municipal notes and municipal leases. Municipal bonds are debt obligations of a governmental entity that obligate the municipality to pay the holder a specified sum of money at specified intervals and to repay the principal amount of the loan at maturity.

Municipal notes may be issued by governmental entities and other tax-exempt issuers in order to finance short-term cash needs or, occasionally, to finance construction. Most municipal notes are general obligations of the issuing entity payable from taxes or designated revenues expected to be received within the relevant fiscal period. Municipal notes generally have maturities of one year or less. Municipal notes can be subdivided into two sub-categories: (i) municipal commercial paper and (ii) municipal demand obligations.

Municipal commercial paper typically consists of very short-term unsecured negotiable promissory notes that are sold, for example, to meet seasonal working capital or interim construction financing needs of a governmental entity or agency. While these obligations are intended to be paid from general revenues or refinanced with long-term debt, they frequently are backed by letters of credit, lending agreements, note repurchase agreements or other credit facility agreements offered by banks or institutions.

 

42


Table of Contents

 

Municipal demand obligations can be subdivided into two general types: variable rate demand notes and master demand obligations. Variable rate demand notes are tax-exempt municipal obligations or participation interests that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid on the notes. They permit the holder to demand payment of the notes, or to demand purchase of the notes at a purchase price equal to the unpaid principal balance, plus accrued interest either directly by the issuer or by drawing on a bank letter of credit or guaranty issued with respect to such note. The issuer of the municipal obligation may have a corresponding right to prepay at its discretion the outstanding principal of the note plus accrued interest upon notice comparable to that required for the holder to demand payment. The variable rate demand notes in which a Fund may invest are payable, or are subject to purchase, on demand usually on notice of seven calendar days or less. The terms of the notes generally provide that interest rates are adjustable at intervals ranging from daily to six months.

Master demand obligations are tax-exempt municipal obligations that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid and permit daily changes in the amount borrowed. The interest on such obligations is, in the opinion of counsel for the borrower, excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes (but not necessarily for alternative minimum tax purposes). Although there is no secondary market for master demand obligations, such obligations are considered by a Fund to be liquid because they are payable upon demand.

Municipal lease obligations are participations in privately arranged loans to state or local government borrowers. In general, such loans are unrated, in which case they will be determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality at the time of purchase to rated instruments that may be acquired by a Fund. Frequently, privately arranged loans have variable interest rates and may be backed by a bank letter of credit. In other cases, they may be unsecured or may be secured by assets not easily liquidated. Moreover, such loans in most cases are not backed by the taxing authority of the issuers and may have limited marketability or may be marketable only by virtue of a provision requiring repayment following demand by the lender.

Although lease obligations do not constitute general obligations of the municipal issuer to which the government’s taxing power is pledged, a lease obligation ordinarily is backed by the government’s covenant to budget for, appropriate, and make the payments due under the lease obligation. However, certain lease obligations contain “non-appropriation” clauses that provide that the government has no obligation to make lease or installment purchase payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a periodic basis. In the case of a “non-appropriation” lease, a Fund’s ability to recover under the lease in the event of non-appropriation or default likely will be limited to the repossession of the leased property in the event that foreclosure proves difficult.

Tender option bonds are municipal securities having relatively long maturities and bearing interest at a fixed interest rate substantially higher than prevailing short-term tax-exempt rates that is coupled with the agreement of a third party, such as a bank, broker/dealer or other financial institution, to grant the security holders the option, at periodic intervals, to tender their securities to the institution and receive the face value thereof. The financial institution receives periodic fees equal to the difference between the municipal security’s coupon rate and the rate that would cause the security to trade at face value on the date of determination.

Investing in municipal securities is subject to certain risks. There are variations in the quality of municipal securities, both within a particular classification and between classifications, and the rates of return on municipal securities can depend on a variety of factors, including general money market conditions, the financial condition of the issuer, general conditions of the municipal bond market, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. The ratings of NRSROs represent their opinions as to the quality of municipal securities. It should be emphasized, however, that these ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality, and municipal securities with the same maturity, interest rate, and rating may have different rates of return while municipal securities of the same maturity and interest rate with different ratings may have the same rate of return.

 

43


Table of Contents

 

The payment of principal and interest on most municipal securities purchased by a Fund will depend upon the ability of the issuers to meet their obligations. An issuer’s obligations under its municipal securities are subject to the provisions of bankruptcy, insolvency, and other laws affecting the rights and remedies of creditors, such as the United States Bankruptcy Code. The power or ability of an issuer to meet its obligations for the payment of interest on and principal of its municipal securities may be materially adversely affected by litigation or other conditions.

There are particular considerations and risks relevant to investing in a portfolio of a single state’s municipal securities, such as the greater risk of the concentration of portfolio holdings.

The Funds ordinarily purchase municipal securities whose interest, in the opinion of bond counsel, is excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes. The opinion of bond counsel may assert that such interest is not an item of tax preference for the purposes of the alternative minimum tax or is exempt from certain state or local taxes. There is no assurance that the applicable taxing authority will agree with this opinion. In the event, for example, the IRS determines that an issuer does not comply with relevant tax requirements, interest payments from a security could become federally taxable, possibly retroactively to the date the security was issued. As a shareholder of the Fund, you may be required to file an amended tax return as a result, reporting such income as taxable.

For more information about the key risks associated with investments in states, see Appendix D.

Participation Interests

Participation interests (also called pass-through certificates or securities) represent an interest in a pool of debt obligations, such as municipal bonds or notes, that have been “packaged” by an intermediary, such as a bank or broker/dealer. Participation interests typically are issued by partnerships or trusts through which a Fund receives principal and interest payments that are passed through to the holder of the participation interest from the payments made on the underlying debt obligations. The purchaser of a participation interest receives an undivided interest in the underlying debt obligations. The issuers of the underlying debt obligations make interest and principal payments to the intermediary, as an initial purchaser, which are passed through to purchasers in the secondary market, such as a Fund. Mortgage-backed securities are a common type of participation interest. Participation interests may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in- kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Loan participations also are a type of participation interest. Loan participations are interests in loans that are administered by a lending bank or agent for a syndicate of lending banks and sold by the bank or syndicate members.

Investing in participation interests is subject to certain risks. Participation interests generally are subject to the credit risk associated with the underlying borrowers. If the underlying borrower defaults, a Fund may be subject to delays, expenses and risks that are greater than those that would have been involved if a Fund had purchased a direct obligation of the borrower. A Fund also may be deemed a creditor of the lending bank or syndicate members and be subject to the risk that the lending bank or syndicate members may become insolvent.

Preferred Stock

Preferred stock represents units of ownership of a corporation that frequently have dividends that are set at a specified rate. Preferred stock has preference over common stock in the payment of dividends and the liquidation of assets. Preferred stock shares some of the characteristics of both debt and equity. Preferred stock ordinarily

 

44


Table of Contents

does not carry voting rights. Most preferred stock is cumulative; if dividends are passed (i.e., not paid for any reason), they accumulate and must be paid before common stock dividends. Participating preferred stock entitles its holders to share in profits above and beyond the declared dividend, along with common shareholders, as distinguished from nonparticipating preferred stock, which is limited to the stipulated dividend. Convertible preferred stock is exchangeable for a given number of shares of common stock and thus tends to be more volatile than nonconvertible preferred stock, which generally behaves more like a fixed income bond. Preferred stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Auction preferred stock (APS) is a type of adjustable-rate preferred stock with a dividend determined periodically in a Dutch auction process by corporate bidders. Shares typically are bought and sold at face values generally ranging from $100,000 to $500,000 per share.

In addition to reinvestment risk if interest rates fall, some specific risks with regard to APS include:

 

   

Failed auction: A breakdown of the auction process can occur. In the event that the process fails, the rate is reset at the maximum applicable rate, which is usually described in the prospectuses and typically is influenced by the issuer’s credit rating. In a failed auction, current shareholders generally are unable to sell some, or all, of the shares when the auction is completed. Typically, the liquidity for APS that have experienced a failed auction becomes very limited. If a failed auction were to occur, the shareholder generally would hold his or her shares until the next auction. Should there not be subsequent auctions that “cure” the failed process, the shareholder may: (1) hold the APS in anticipation of a refinancing by the issuer that would cause the APS to be called, or (2) hold securities either indefinitely or in anticipation of the development of a secondary market.

 

   

Early call risk: APS generally is redeemable at any time, usually upon notice, at the issuer’s option, at par plus accrued dividends.

Investing in preferred stock is subject to certain risks. For example, stock market risk is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when prices generally rise and periods when prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and decline based on factors specific to each corporation, such as changes in earnings or management.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular company. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price fluctuations than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, are more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Stocks of these companies may have a higher potential for gains but also are subject to greater risk of loss.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably affect, an industry, the prices of the stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the value of those companies’ stock to decline.

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

Private placement securities are securities that have been privately placed and are not registered under the 1933 Act. They are eligible for sale only to certain eligible investors. Private placements often may offer attractive opportunities for investment not otherwise available on the open market. Private placement and other

 

45


Table of Contents

“restricted” securities often cannot be sold to the public without registration under the 1933 Act or the availability of an exemption from registration (such as Rules 144 or 144A), or they are “not readily marketable” because they are subject to other legal or contractual delays in or restrictions on resale. Asset-backed securities, common stock, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, preferred stock and other types of equity and debt instruments may be privately placed or restricted securities.

Private placements typically may be sold only to qualified institutional buyers (or, in the case of the initial sale of certain securities, such as those issued in collateralized debt obligations or collateralized loan obligations, to accredited investors (as defined in Rule 501(a) under the 1933 Act), or in a privately negotiated transaction or to a limited number of purchasers, or in limited quantities after they have been held for a specified period of time and other conditions are met pursuant to an exemption from registration.

Investing in private placement and other restricted securities is subject to certain risks. Private placements may be considered illiquid securities. Private placements typically are subject to restrictions on resale as a matter of contract or under federal securities laws. Because there may be relatively few potential purchasers for such securities, especially under adverse market or economic conditions or in the event of adverse changes in the financial condition of the issuer, a Fund could find it more difficult to sell such securities when it may be advisable to do so or it may be able to sell such securities only at prices lower than if such securities were more widely held. At times, it also may be more difficult to determine the fair value of such securities for purposes of computing a Fund’s net asset value due to the absence of a trading market.

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

REITs are entities that either own properties or make construction or mortgage loans and also may include operating or finance companies. An equity REIT generally holds equity positions in real estate and seeks to provide its shareholders with income from the leasing of its properties and with capital gains from any sales of properties. A mortgage REIT generally specializes in lending money to owners of properties and passes through any interest income it may earn to its shareholders.

Partnership units of real estate and other types of companies sometimes are organized as master limited partnerships in which ownership interests are publicly traded. Master limited partnerships often own several properties or businesses (or directly own interests) that are related to real estate development and the oil and gas industries, but they also may finance motion pictures, research and development and other projects.

REITs are subject to certain risks associated with direct ownership of real estate, including, for example, declines in the value of real estate, risks related to general and local economic conditions, overbuilding and increased competition, increases in property taxes and operating expenses, and variations in rental income. REITs also may be subject to interest rate risk. In general, increases in interest rates will decrease the value of high-yield securities and increase the costs of obtaining financing, which could decrease the value of a REIT’s investments. In addition, equity REITs may be affected by changes in the value of the underlying property owned by the REITs, while mortgage REITs may be affected by the quality of credit extended. Both equity and mortgage REITs are dependent upon management skills. REITs also may be subject to heavy cash flow dependency, defaults by borrowers, and the possibility of failing to qualify for preferential tax treatment under the Code, which could adversely affect dividend payments. REITs also may not be diversified.

Investing in master limited partnerships generally is subject to the risks applicable to investing in a partnership as opposed to a corporation, which may include fewer protections afforded to investors. Additional risks include those associated with the specific industries in which a master limited partnership invests, such as the risks associated with investing in the real estate or oil and gas industries.

 

46


Table of Contents

 

Repurchase Agreements

Repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund acquires a security for a relatively short period of time subject to the obligation of a seller to repurchase and a Fund to resell such security at a fixed time and price (representing a Fund’s cost plus interest). Repurchase agreements also may be viewed as loans made by a Fund that are collateralized by the securities subject to repurchase. A Fund typically will enter into repurchase agreements only with commercial banks, registered broker/dealers and the Fixed Income Clearing Corporation. Such transactions are monitored to ensure that the value of the underlying securities will be at least equal at all times to the total amount of the repurchase obligation, including any accrued interest. Repurchase agreements generally are subject to counterparty risk.

If a counterparty defaults, a Fund could realize a loss on the sale of the underlying security to the extent that the proceeds of the sale are less than the resale price provided in the repurchase agreement including interest. In the event that a counterparty fails to perform because it is insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund’s right to take possession of the underlying securities would be subject to applicable insolvency law and procedure, including an automatic stay (which would preclude immediate enforcement of a Fund’s rights) and exemptions thereto (which would permit a Fund to take possession of the underlying securities or to void a repurchase agreement altogether). Since it is possible that an exemption from the automatic stay would not be available, a Fund might be prevented from immediately enforcing its rights against the counterparty. Accordingly, if a counterparty becomes insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund may incur delays in or be prevented from liquidating the underlying securities and could experience losses, including the possible decline in value of the underlying securities during the period in which a Fund seeks to enforce its rights thereto, possible subnormal levels of income or lack of access to income during such time, as well as the costs incurred in enforcing a Fund’s rights. For example, if a Fund enters into a repurchase agreement with a broker that becomes insolvent, it is possible for the Securities Investor Protection Corporation (SIPC) to institute a liquidation proceeding in federal court against the broker counterparty which could lead to a foreclosure by SIPC of the underlying securities or SIPC may stay, or preclude, a Fund’s ability under contract to terminate the repurchase agreement.

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

Reverse repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund sells a security subject to the obligation of a buyer to resell and a Fund to repurchase such security at a fixed time and price. Reverse repurchase agreements also may be viewed as borrowings made by a Fund.

Reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase under the agreement may decline below the repurchase price. In the event the buyer of securities under a reverse repurchase agreement files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the agreement may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, reverse repurchase agreements are techniques involving leverage, and are subject to asset coverage requirements. Under the requirements of the 1940 Act, a Fund is required to maintain an asset coverage (including the proceeds of the borrowings) of at least 300% of all borrowings.

Standby Commitments

Standby commitments are securities under which a purchaser, usually a bank or broker/dealer, agrees to purchase, for a fee, an amount of a Fund’s municipal obligations. The amount payable by a bank or broker/dealer to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment typically will be substantially the same as the value of the underlying municipal securities. A Fund may pay for standby commitments either separately in cash or by paying a higher price for portfolio securities that are acquired subject to such a commitment.

Using standby commitments is subject to certain risks. Standby commitments are subject to the risk that a counterparty will not fulfill its obligation to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment.

 

47


Table of Contents

 

Stripped Securities

Stripped securities are securities that evidence ownership in either the future interest or principal payments on an instrument. There are many different types and variations of stripped securities. For example, Separate Trading of Registered Interest and Principal Securities (STRIPS), can be component parts of a U.S. Treasury security where the principal and interest components are traded independently through DTC, a clearing agency registered pursuant to Section 17A of the 1934 Act and created to hold securities for its participants, and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between participants through electronic computerized book-entries, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of certificates. Treasury Investor Growth Receipts (TIGERs) are U.S. Treasury securities stripped by brokers. Stripped mortgage-backed securities, or SMBS, also can be issued by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Stripped securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

SMBS usually are structured with two or more classes that receive different proportions of the interest and principal distributions from a pool of mortgage-backed assets. Common types of SMBS will be structured so that one class receives some of the interest and most of the principal from the mortgage-backed assets, while another class receives most of the interest and the remainder of the principal.

Investing in stripped securities is subject to certain risks. If the underlying obligations experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, a Fund may fail fully to recoup its initial investment in such securities. The market value of the class consisting primarily or entirely of principal payments can be especially volatile in response to changes in interest rates. The rates of return on a class of SMBS that receives all or most of the interest are generally higher than prevailing market rates of return on other mortgage-backed obligations because their cash flow patterns also are volatile and there is a greater risk that the initial investment will not be recouped fully.

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

U.S. Government obligations include U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government or by various instrumentalities which have been established or sponsored by the U.S. Government. U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government differ in their interest rates, maturities and time of issuance, as well as with respect to whether they are guaranteed by the U.S. Government. U.S. Government and related obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

U.S. Government obligations also include senior unsecured debt securities issued between October 14, 2008 and June 30, 2009 by eligible issuers (including U.S. depository institutions insured by the FDIC (and certain affiliates), U.S. bank holding companies and certain U.S. savings and loan holding companies) that are guaranteed by the FDIC under its Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (the “TLGP”). The FDIC’s guarantee under the TLGP will expire upon the earlier of (i) maturity of such security or (ii) June 30, 2012. It is the view of the FDIC and the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission that any debt security that is guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP and that has a maturity that ends on or before June 30, 2012 would be a security exempt from registration under Section 3(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933 because such security would be fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the FDIC.

Investing in securities guaranteed under the TLGP is subject to certain risks. Given that there is a limited track record for securities guaranteed under the TLGP, it is uncertain whether such securities will continue to trade in line with recent experience in relation to treasury and government agency securities in terms of yield spread and the volatility of such spread and it is uncertain how such securities will trade in the secondary market and whether that market will be liquid or illiquid. The TLGP is a new program that is subject to change. In order

 

48


Table of Contents

to collect from the FDIC under the TLGP, a claims process must be followed. Failure to follow the claims process could result in a loss to the right to payment under the guarantee. In addition, guarantee payments by the FDIC under the TLGP may be delayed.

Investing in U.S. Government and related obligations is subject to certain risks. While U.S. Treasury obligations are backed by the “full faith and credit” of the U.S. Government, securities issued or guaranteed by federal agencies and U.S. Government-sponsored instrumentalities may or may not be backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. These securities may be supported by the ability to borrow from the U.S. Treasury or only by the credit of the issuing agency or instrumentality and, as a result, may be subject to greater credit risk than securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Treasury. Obligations of U.S. Government agencies, authorities, instrumentalities and sponsored enterprises historically have involved limited risk of loss of principal if held to maturity. However, no assurance can be given that the U.S. Government would provide financial support to any of these entities if it is not obligated to do so by law.

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

Variable- and floating-rate obligations provide for periodic adjustments in the interest rate and, under certain circumstances, varying principal amounts. Unlike a fixed interest rate, a variable, or floating, rate is one that rises and declines based on the movement of an underlying index of interest rates and may pay interest at rates that are adjusted periodically according to a specified formula. Asset-backed securities, bank obligations, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as variable- and floating-rate obligations.

Investing in variable- and floating-rate obligations is subject to certain risks. Variable- and floating-rate obligations may involve direct lending arrangements between the purchaser and the issuer and there may be no active secondary market, making it difficult to resell such obligations to a third party. Variable- and floating-rate obligations also may be subject to interest rate and credit risks. Changes in interest rates can affect the rate of return on such obligations. If an issuer of a variable- or floating-rate obligation defaults, a Fund could sustain a loss to the extent of such default.

Warrants and Rights

Warrants and rights are types of securities that give a holder a right to purchase shares of common stock. Warrants usually are issued together with a bond or preferred stock and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock at a specified price typically for a period of years. Rights usually have a specified purchase price that is lower than the current market price and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock typically for a period of only weeks. Warrants may be used to enhance the marketability of a bond or preferred stock.

Warrants and rights may be subject to the risk that the securities could lose value. There also is the risk that the potential exercise price may exceed the market price of the warrants or rights, such as when there is no movement in the market price or the market price of such securities declines.

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the purchase or sale of securities by a Fund, with payment and delivery taking place in the future. When engaging in when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions, a Fund typically will hold cash or liquid securities in a segregated account in an amount equal to or greater than the purchase price. The payment obligation and, if applicable, the interest rate that will be received on the securities, are fixed at the time that a Fund agrees to purchase the securities. A Fund generally will enter into when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment

 

49


Table of Contents

transactions only with the intention of completing such transactions. However, the Adviser may determine not to complete a transaction if it deems it appropriate. In such cases, a Fund may realize short-term gains or losses.

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the risks that the securities purchased may fall in value by the time they actually are issued or that the other party may fail to honor the contract terms. A Fund that invests in delayed delivery securities may rely on a third party to complete the transaction. Failure by a third party to deliver a security purchased on a delayed delivery basis may result in a financial loss to a Fund or the loss of an opportunity to make an alternative investment.

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

Zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities are types of debt instruments that do not necessarily make payments of interest in fixed amounts or at fixed intervals. Asset-backed securities, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities.

Zero-coupon securities do not pay interest on a current basis but instead accrue interest over the life of the security. These securities include, among others, zero-coupon bonds, which either may be issued at a discount by a corporation or government entity or may be created by a brokerage firm when it strips the coupons from a bond or note and then sells the bond or note and the coupon separately. This technique is used frequently with U.S. Treasury bonds, and zero-coupon securities are marketed under such names as CATS (Certificate of Accrual on Treasury Securities), TIGERs or STRIPS. Zero-coupon bonds also are issued by municipalities. Buying a municipal zero-coupon bond frees its purchaser of the obligation to pay regular federal income tax on imputed interest, since the interest is exempt for regular federal income tax purposes. Zero-coupon certificates of deposit and zero-coupon mortgages are generally structured in the same fashion as zero-coupon bonds; the certificate of deposit holder or mortgage holder receives face value at maturity and no payments until then.

Pay-in-kind securities normally give the issuer an option to pay cash at a coupon payment date or to give the holder of the security a similar security with the same coupon rate and a face value equal to the amount of the coupon payment that would have been made.

Step-coupon securities trade at a discount from their face value and pay coupon interest. The coupon rate is paid according to a schedule for a series of periods, typically lower for an initial period and then increasing to a higher coupon rate thereafter. The discount from the face amount or par value depends on the time remaining until cash payments begin, prevailing interest rates, liquidity of the security and the perceived credit quality of the issue.

Zero-coupon, step-coupon and pay-in-kind securities holders generally have substantially all the rights and privileges of holders of the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations. Holders of these securities have the right upon default on the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations to proceed directly and individually against the issuer and are not required to act in concert with other holders of such securities.

Investing in zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities is subject to certain risks, including that market prices of zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities generally are more volatile than the prices of securities that pay interest periodically and in cash, and are likely to respond to changes in interest rates to a greater degree than other types of debt securities.

Because zero-coupon securities bear no interest, they are volatile. Since zero-coupon bondholders do not receive interest payments, zero-coupon securities fall more dramatically than bonds paying interest on a current basis when interest rates rise. However, when interest rates fall, zero-coupon securities rise more rapidly in value than interest paying bonds.

 

50


Table of Contents

 

Borrowings

Each Fund has a fundamental policy with respect to borrowing that can be found under the heading About the Funds’ Investments – Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies. Specifically, each Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds. In general, pursuant to the 1940 Act, a Fund may borrow money only from banks in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings). Any borrowings that come to exceed this amount must be reduced within three days (not including Sundays and holidays) to the extent necessary to comply with the 33 1/3% limitation.

The Funds participate in a committed line of credit (Line of Credit). Any advance under the Line of Credit is contemplated primarily for temporary or emergency purposes, including the meeting of redemption requests that otherwise might require the untimely sale of portfolio securities.

Pursuant to an exemptive order from the SEC, a Fund may, subject to certain conditions, borrow money from or lend money to other funds in the Columbia Funds Family or any other registered investment company advised by the Adviser or its affiliates for temporary emergency purposes in order to facilitate redemption requests, or for other purposes consistent with Fund investment policies and restrictions. All loans are set at an interest rate between the rates charged on overnight repurchase agreements and short-term bank loans.

Short Sales

A Fund may sometimes sell securities short when it owns an equal amount of such securities as those securities sold short. This is a technique known as selling short “against the box.” If a Fund makes a short sale “against the box,” it would not immediately deliver the securities sold and would not receive the proceeds from the sale. The seller is said to have a short position in the securities sold until it delivers the securities sold, at which time it receives the proceeds of the sale. To secure its obligation to deliver securities sold short, a Fund will deposit in escrow in a separate account with the custodian an equal amount of the securities sold short or securities convertible into or exchangeable for such securities. A Fund can close out its short position by purchasing and delivering an equal amount of the securities sold short, rather than by delivering securities already held by a Fund, because a Fund might want to continue to receive interest and dividend payments on securities in its portfolio that are convertible into the securities sold short.

Short sales “against the box” entail many of the same risks and considerations described above regarding short sales not “against the box.” However, when a Fund sells short “against the box” it typically limits the amount of securities that it has leveraged. A Fund’s decision to make a short sale “against the box” may be a technique to hedge against market risks when the Adviser believes that the price of a security may decline, causing a decline in the value of a security owned by a Fund or a security convertible into or exchangeable for such security. In such case, any future losses in a Fund’s long position would be reduced by a gain in the short position. The extent to which such gains or losses in the long position are reduced will depend upon the amount of securities sold short relative to the amount of the securities a Fund owns, either directly or indirectly, and, in the case where a Fund owns convertible securities, changes in the investment values or conversion premiums of such securities. Short sales may have adverse tax consequences to a Fund and its shareholders.

Subject to its fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies, a Fund may engage in short sales that are not “against the box,” which are sales by a Fund of securities or commodity futures contracts that it does not own in hopes of purchasing the same security at a later date at a lower price. The technique is also used to protect a profit in a long-term position in a security or commodity futures contract. To make delivery to the buyer, a Fund must borrow or purchase the security. If borrowed, a Fund is then obligated to replace the security borrowed from the third party, so a Fund must purchase the security at the market price at a later time. If the price of the security has increased during this time, then a Fund will incur a loss equal to the increase in price of

 

51


Table of Contents

the security from the time of the short sale plus any premiums and interest paid to the third party. (Until the security is replaced, a Fund is required to pay to the lender amounts equal to any dividends or interest which accrue during the period of the loan. To borrow the security, a Fund also may be required to pay a premium, which would increase the cost of the security sold. The proceeds of the short sale will be retained by the broker, to the extent necessary to meet the margin requirements, until the short position is closed out.)

Short sales by a Fund that are not made “against the box” create opportunities to increase a Fund’s return but, at the same time, involve specific risk considerations and may be considered a speculative technique. Because a Fund in effect profits from a decline in the price of the securities sold short without the need to invest the full purchase price of the securities on the date of the short sale, a Fund’s NAV per share tends to increase more when the securities it has sold short decrease in value, and to decrease more when the securities it has sold short increase in value, than if it had not engaged in such short sales. The amount of any gain will be decreased, and the amount of any loss increased, by the amount of any premium, dividends or interest a Fund may be required to pay in connection with the short sale. Short sales could potentially involve unlimited loss, as the market price of securities sold short may continually increase, although a Fund can mitigate any such losses by replacing the securities sold short. Under adverse market conditions, a Fund might have difficulty purchasing securities to meet its short sale delivery obligations, and might have to sell portfolio securities to raise the capital necessary to meet its short sale obligations at a time when fundamental investment considerations would not favor such sales. There is also the risk that the third party to the short sale may fail to honor its contract terms, causing a loss to a Fund.

A Fund’s successful use of short sales also will be subject to the ability of the Adviser to predict movements in the directions of the relevant market. A Fund therefore bears the risk that the Adviser will incorrectly predict future price directions. In addition, if a Fund sells a security short, and that security’s price goes up, a Fund will have to make up the margin on its open position (i.e., purchase more securities on the market to cover the position). It may be unable to do so and thus its position may not be closed out. There can be no assurance that a Fund will not incur significant losses in such a case.

In the view of the SEC, a short sale involves the creation of a “senior security” as such term is defined in the 1940 Act, unless the sale is “against the box” and the securities sold short are placed in a segregated account (not with the broker), or unless a Fund’s obligation to deliver the securities sold short is “covered” by placing in a segregated account (not with the broker) cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities in an amount equal to the difference between the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale and any such collateral required to be deposited with a broker in connection with the sale (not including the proceeds from the short sale), which difference is adjusted daily for changes in the value of the securities sold short. The total value of the cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities deposited with the broker and otherwise segregated may not at any time be less than the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale.

Lending Securities

Securities lending refers to the lending of the Fund’s portfolio securities. Subject to its investment policies described above and in the prospectuses, the Fund may make secured loans of its portfolio securities to broker/dealers and other institutional investors. Securities loans by the Fund are made pursuant to agreements that require that loans be secured continuously by collateral in cash. The Fund retains all or a portion of the income received on investment of cash collateral. A borrower will pay to the Fund an amount equal to any dividends or interest received on securities loaned, but the borrower typically will receive a portion of the income earned on investments of cash collateral. Although voting rights, or rights to consent, with respect to loaned securities pass to a borrower, the Fund retains the right to call the loans at any time on reasonable notice, and may do so in order to vote upon matters affecting, or to sell, the loaned securities.

The Fund typically invests the cash collateral it receives in connection with its securities lending program directly or indirectly in high quality, short-term investments. The Fund may invest some or all of such cash

 

52


Table of Contents

collateral in one or more pooled investment vehicles, including, among other vehicles, money market funds managed by the Fund’s securities lending agent or its affiliates. The securities lending agent shares in any income resulting from the investment of such cash collateral, and an affiliate of the securities lending agent receives asset-based fees for the management of such pooled investment vehicles, which may create a conflict of interest between the securities lending agent (or its affiliate) and the Fund with respect to the management of such cash collateral.

Engaging in securities lending is subject to certain risks, including counterparty risk, which is the risk that the counterparty to a transaction could default. There also is a risk of possible delay in the recovery of loaned securities or possible loss of rights in the collateral if a borrower fails financially.

Portfolio Turnover

A change in the securities held by a Fund is known as “portfolio turnover.” High portfolio turnover (e.g., over 100%) involves correspondingly greater expenses to the Fund, including brokerage commissions or dealer mark-ups and other transaction costs on the sale of securities and reinvestments in other securities. Such sales may also result in adverse tax consequences to a Fund’s shareholders. The trading costs and tax effects associated with portfolio turnover may adversely affect a Fund’s performance.

For each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate, see the Fees and Expenses of the Fund — Portfolio Turnover section in the prospectuses for that Fund.

In any particular year, market conditions may result in greater rates than are presently anticipated. The rate of a Fund’s turnover may vary significantly from time to time depending on the volatility of economic and market conditions.

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

The Board has adopted policies and procedures with respect to the disclosure of each Fund’s portfolio holdings. These policies and procedures are designed to ensure that disclosure of information regarding a Fund’s portfolio securities is in the best interests of Fund shareholders and to address conflicts between the interests of Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Fund, on the other. These policies and procedures provide that a Fund’s portfolio holdings information generally may not be disclosed to any party prior to the earlier of: (i) the business day next following the posting of such information on the Columbia Funds’ website, if applicable, or (ii) the time a Fund discloses the information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information. Certain limited exceptions that have been approved consistent with the policies and procedures are described below. The Board is updated as needed regarding compliance with these policies and procedures. The policies and procedures prohibit the Adviser and a Fund’s other service providers from entering into any agreement to disclose Fund portfolio holdings information in exchange for any form of consideration. The same policies and procedures apply to all categories of Columbia Funds and include some variations tailored to the different categories of Columbia Funds. Accordingly, some of the provisions described below do not apply to the Columbia Funds covered by this SAI. The Adviser also has adopted policies and procedures to monitor for compliance with these portfolio holdings disclosure policies and procedures.

Public Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings are currently disclosed to the public through required filings with the SEC and on the Columbia Funds’ website. This information is available on the Columbia Funds’ website as described below.

 

   

For equity, convertible, balanced and asset allocation Columbia Funds, other than small cap and specialty Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 15 calendar days after such month-end.

 

53


Table of Contents

 

   

For small cap and specialty Columbia Funds and those Columbia Funds that are sub-advised by Marsico and Brandes, subadvisers for certain Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such month-end.

 

   

For fixed-income funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a calendar quarter-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such quarter-end.

 

   

For money market funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of month-end are posted on the Columbia Funds’ website on a monthly basis, approximately five business days after such month-end. Commencing with the month-end holdings as of September 2010 and thereafter, such month-end holdings will be continuously available on the website for at least six months, together with a link to an SEC webpage where a user of the website may obtain access to the fund’s most recent 12 months of publicly available filings on Form N-MFP. Additionally, as of September 2010 and thereafter, money market fund portfolio holdings information posted on the website will, at minimum, include with respect to each holding, the name of the issuer, the category of investment (e.g., Treasury debt, government agency debt, asset backed commercial paper, structured investment vehicle note), the CUSIP number (if any), the principal amount, the maturity date (as determined under Rule 2a-7 for purposes of calculating weighted average maturity), the final maturity date (if different from the maturity date previously described), coupon or yield and the amortized cost value. The money market funds will also disclose on the website the overall weighted average maturity and weighted average life maturity of a holding.

The Adviser makes publicly available information regarding certain Columbia Fund’s largest five to fifteen holdings, as a percent of the market value of the Columbia Funds’ portfolios as of a month-end. This holdings information is made publicly available through the website generally no earlier than fifteen (15) days following the month-end.

The Adviser may also disclose more current portfolio holdings information as of specified dates on the Columbia Funds’ website.

The scope of the information that is made available on the Columbia Funds’ website pursuant to the Columbia Funds’ policies relating to a Columbia Fund’s portfolio may change from time to time without prior notice. The Columbia Funds file their portfolio holdings with the SEC for each fiscal quarter on Form N-CSR (with respect to each annual period and semi-annual period) and Form N-Q (with respect to the first and third quarters of each Columbia Fund’s fiscal year). Shareholders may obtain each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, a link to which is provided on the Columbia Funds’ website. In addition, each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings may be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s public reference room in Washington, D.C. You may call the SEC at 202.551.8090 for information about the SEC’s website or the operation of the public reference room.

The Columbia Funds, the Adviser and their affiliates may include portfolio holdings information that already has been made public through a website posting or SEC filing in marketing literature and other communications to shareholders, advisors or other parties, provided that the information is disclosed no earlier than the business day after the date the information is disclosed publicly on the Columbia Funds’ website or no earlier than the time a Columbia Fund files such information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information.

Other Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ policies and procedures provide that no disclosures of the Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings may be made prior to the portfolio holdings information being made public unless (i) the Columbia Funds have a legitimate business purpose for making such disclosure, (ii) the Columbia Funds’ President authorizes such non-public disclosure of information, and (iii) the party receiving the non-public information enters into an appropriate confidentiality agreement or is otherwise subject to a confidentiality obligation.

 

54


Table of Contents

 

In determining the existence of a legitimate business purpose for making portfolio disclosures, the following factors, among others, are considered: (i) any prior disclosure must be consistent with the anti-fraud provisions of the federal securities laws and the fiduciary duties of the Adviser; (ii) any conflicts of interest between the interests of Columbia Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Columbia Fund, on the other; and (iii) any prior disclosure to a third party, although subject to a confidentiality agreement, would not make conduct lawful that otherwise is unlawful.

In addition, the Columbia Funds periodically disclose their portfolio information on a confidential basis to various service providers that require such information to assist the Columbia Funds with their day-to-day business affairs. In addition to the Adviser and its affiliates, these service providers include each Columbia Fund’s subadviser(s) (if any), the Columbia Funds’ custodian, sub-custodians, independent registered public accounting firm, legal counsel, financial printers, proxy solicitor and proxy voting service provider, as well as ratings agencies that maintain ratings on certain Columbia Funds. These service providers are required to keep such information confidential, and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information except as necessary in providing services to the Columbia Funds. The Columbia Funds also may disclose portfolio holdings information to broker/dealers and certain other entities in connection with potential transactions and management of the Columbia Funds, provided that reasonable precautions, including limitations on the scope of the portfolio holdings information disclosed, are taken to avoid any potential misuse of the disclosed information.

Each Columbia Fund’s Board has adopted policies to ensure that the Columbia Fund’s holdings information is only disclosed in accordance with these policies. Before any selective disclosure of holdings information is permitted, the person seeking to disclose such holdings information must submit a written request to the Portfolio Holdings Committee (“PHC”). The PHC is comprised of members from the Adviser’s legal department, the Adviser’s compliance department, and the Columbia Funds’ President. The PHC has been authorized by each Columbia Fund’s Board to perform an initial review of requests for disclosure of holdings information to evaluate whether there is a legitimate business purpose for selective disclosure, whether selective disclosure is in the best interests of a fund and its shareholders, to consider any potential conflicts of interest between the fund, the investment adviser, and its affiliates, and to safeguard against improper use of holdings information. Factors considered in this analysis are whether the recipient has agreed to or has a duty to keep the holdings information confidential and whether risks have been mitigated such that the recipient has agreed or has a duty to use the holdings information only as necessary to effectuate the purpose for which selective disclosure was authorized, including a duty not to trade on such information. Before portfolio holdings may be selectively disclosed, requests approved by the PHC must also be authorized by either the Columbia Fund’s President, Chief Compliance Officer or General Counsel or their respective designees. On at least an annual basis, the PHC reviews the approved recipients of selective disclosure and may require a resubmission of the request, in order to re-authorize certain ongoing arrangements. These procedures are intended to be reasonably designed to protect the confidentiality of fund holdings information and to prohibit their release to individual investors, institutional investors, intermediaries that distribute the Columbia Funds’ shares, and other parties, until such holdings information is made public or unless such persons have been authorized to receive such holdings information on a selective basis, as set forth above.

 

55


Table of Contents

 

The Columbia Funds currently have ongoing arrangements with certain approved recipients with respect to the disclosure of portfolio holdings information prior to such information being made public. Portfolio holdings information disclosed to such recipients is current as of the time of its disclosure, is disclosed to each recipient solely for purposes consistent with the services described below and has been authorized by the Columbia Funds’ President. These special arrangements are described in the table below.

Ongoing Portfolio Holdings Disclosure Arrangements

 

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
    

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS ON
USE OF INFORMATION

   FREQUENCY OF
DISCLOSURE

Standard & Poor’s

     None       Use to maintain ratings for certain money market funds.    Weekly

InvestorTools, Inc.

     None       Access granted solely for the purpose of testing back office conversion of trading systems.    Real time

ING Insurance Company

     None       Access granted for specific Columbia Funds for ING’s creation of client/shareholder materials. ING may not distribute materials until the holdings information is made public.    Quarterly

Glass-Lewis & Co.

     None       Access in connection with testing the firm’s proxy services.    Daily

CMS Bondedge

     None       Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with application used by the Adviser’s Fixed Income Portfolio Management team as an analytical and trading tool.    Ad hoc

Linedata Services, Inc.

     None       Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with the software for the LongView Trade Order Management System.    Ad hoc

JP Morgan

     None       Access to provide the Adviser’s High Yield portfolio management team with peer group analysis reports for purposes of analyzing the portfolio.    Monthly

Malaspina Communications

     None       Use to facilitate writing, publishing and mailing Columbia Fund shareholder reports and communications including shareholder letters and management’s discussion of Columbia Fund performance.    Quarterly

Evare LLP

     None       Use for standardizing and reformatting data according to the Adviser’s specifications for use in the reconciliation process.    Daily

 

56


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
    

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS ON
USE OF INFORMATION

   FREQUENCY OF
DISCLOSURE

FactSet Research Systems, Inc.

     None       Use for provision of quantitative analytics, charting and fundamental data to the Adviser and Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
RR Donnelley/WE Andrews      None       Access as printers for the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs, fact sheets and brochures.    Monthly
Merrill Corporation      None       Use to provide fulfillment of the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs and sales materials.    Monthly
Citigroup      None       Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with Yield Book, an analytic software program that the Adviser uses to perform ongoing risk analysis and management of certain fixed income Columbia Funds and fixed income separately managed accounts.    Daily
Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS)      None       Proxy voting administration and research on proxy matters utilized by MacKay Shields LLC, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
Cogent Consulting LLC      None       Utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds, to facilitate the evaluation of commission rates and to provide flexible commission reporting.    Daily
Moody’s      None       Ongoing portfolio surveillance for ratings it maintains on certain money market funds.    Monthly
Kynex      None       Use to provide portfolio attribution reports.    Daily
Bowne & Co.      None       Use for printing of the following materials: prospectuses, supplements and SAIs.    Monthly/
quarterly
Bloomberg      None       Use for portfolio analytics.    Daily
Barclays Point      None       Use for analytics including risk and attribution assessment.    Daily
Broadridge Financial Solutions, Inc.      None       Proxy voting and research utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily

 

57


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
    

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS ON
USE OF INFORMATION

   FREQUENCY OF
DISCLOSURE
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Macgregor)      None       Order management system utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds that stores trading data and is used for trading and compliance purposes.    Ad hoc
Advent/AXP      None       Portfolio accounting system utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds, for both portfolio accounting and internal recordkeeping purposes.    Ad hoc
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Plexus Group)      None       Evaluation and assessment of trading activity, execution and practices by the Adviser.    Five days
after
quarter-end
BANA and State Street      None       Credit analysis performed by lenders.    Ad hoc
State Street      None       Use to provide custodian services.    Real time
Lipper      None       Use to create metrics for board and executive management reporting, product and marketing analysis, and fund performance.    Daily
Morningstar, Inc.      None       Use for independent research and ranking of Columbia Funds.    Daily

 

58


Table of Contents

 

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly, RiverSource Investments, LLC) (the Adviser) is the investment adviser and administrator of the Funds. The Adviser is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial. Ameriprise Financial is located at 1099 Ameriprise Financial Center, Minneapolis, MN 55474. The Adviser is located at 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110. Prior to May 1, 2010, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (the Previous Adviser), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Bank of America, was the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator.

Services Provided

Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, the Adviser has contracted to furnish each Fund with investment research and advice. For these services, each Fund pays a monthly fee to the Adviser based on the average of the daily closing value of the total net assets of a Fund for such month. Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, any liability of the Adviser to the Trust, a Fund and/or its shareholders is limited to situations involving the Adviser’s own willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence in the performance of its duties or reckless disregard of its obligations and duties.

The Investment Management Services Agreement may be terminated with respect to a Fund at any time on 60 days’ written notice by the Adviser or by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund. The Investment Management Services Agreement will automatically terminate upon any assignment thereof, will continue in effect for two years from May 1, 2010 and thereafter will continue from year to year with respect to a Fund only so long as such continuance is approved at least annually (i) by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund and (ii) by vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as such term is defined in the 1940 Act) of the Adviser or the Trust, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval.

The Adviser pays all compensation of the Trustees and officers of the Trust who are employees of the Adviser, except for the Chief Compliance Officer, a portion of whose salary is paid by the Columbia Funds. Except to the extent expressly assumed by the Adviser and except to the extent required by law to be paid or reimbursed by the Adviser, the Adviser does not have a duty to pay any Fund operating expense incurred in the organization and operation of a Fund, including, but not limited to, auditing, legal, custodial, investor servicing and shareholder reporting expenses. The Trust pays the cost of printing and mailing Fund prospectuses to shareholders.

The Adviser, at its own expense, provides office space, facilities and supplies, equipment and personnel for the performance of its functions under each Fund’s Investment Management Services Agreement.

Advisory Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

Each Fund pays the Adviser an annual fee for its investment advisory services, as set forth in the Investment Management Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Fees and Expenses of the Fund Annual Fund Operating Expenses in each Fund’s prospectuses. The fee is calculated as a percentage of the average daily net assets of each Fund and is paid monthly. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor and/or to selling and/or servicing agents for services they provide.

 

59


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser receives a monthly investment advisory fee based on each Fund’s average daily net assets at the following annual rates:

 

Fund

   First $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $1.5
billion
    Next $3
billion
    In excess
of $6
billion
 

Bond Fund

     0.65     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Contrarian Core Fund

     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.53     0.51

Corporate Income Fund

     0.42     0.375     0.37     0.34     0.33     0.32

Dividend Income Fund

     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.53     0.51

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     0.60     0.60     0.52     0.47     0.45     0.43

Intermediate Bond Fund

     0.35     0.35     0.30     0.29     0.28     0.27

Pacific/Asia Fund

     0.75     0.75     0.67     0.62     0.57     0.52

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     0.75     0.75     0.52     0.47     0.45     0.43

 

Fund

   All
assets
 

Balanced Fund

     0.50

Real Estate Equity Fund

     0.75

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     0.10

 

Fund

   First $1
billion
    Next $2
billion
    In excess
of $3
billion
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     0.50     0.45     0.40

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    Next
$500
million
    Next
$500
million
    In excess
of $1.5
billion
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.52     0.49

International Bond Fund

     0.55     0.50     0.47     0.44

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     0.82     0.75     0.72     0.67

Strategic Income Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.52     0.49

 

Fund

   First $750
million
    Next $250
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $1.5
billion
    Next $3
billion
    In excess
of $6
billion
 

Emerging Markets Fund

     1.15     1.00     0.67     0.62     0.57     0.52

 

Fund

   First $100
million
    Next $100
million
    In excess
of $200
million
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

     0.450     0.425     0.400

 

Fund

   First $200
million
    Next $300
million
    In excess
of $500
million
 

Large Cap Growth Fund

     0.700     0.575     0.450

 

Fund

   First $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $500
million
    In excess
of $2
billion
 

Small Cap Core Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55

 

60


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   First $500
million
    Next $500
million
    In excess
of $1
billion
 

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     0.87     0.82     0.77

Small Cap Value Fund I

     0.80     0.75     0.70

Strategic Investor Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.50

 

Fund

   First $10
billion
    In excess
of $10
billion
 

Value and Restructuring Fund

     0.60     0.43

Advisory Fees Paid by the Funds

The Adviser and the Previous Adviser received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show the advisory fees paid to and, as applicable, waived/reimbursed by the Adviser and the Previous Adviser, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,555,388       $ 3,357,269       $ 3,573,130   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 1,762,911       $ 968,294       $ 981,002   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,172,793       $ 2,165,208       $ 2,762,711   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 4,059,904       $ 6,822,851       $ 15,695,279   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 133,614       $ 710,637         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,382,995       $ 3,524,919       $ 4,061,431   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 6,768,041       $ 7,167,840       $ 7,648,763   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 219,007       $ 634,182       $ 1,872,501   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 131,463       $ 37,003         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 10,061,635       $ 7,032,799       $ 6,446,350   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 374,018       $ 360,167       $ 183,771   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 659,969       $ 380,634       $ 163,118   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

61


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 38,153,435       $ 45,997,660       $ 54,318,105   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

High Yield Opportunity Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 167,714       $ 1,881,734       $ 1,848,657       $ 2,186,530   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 57,327       $ 83,858         —         $ 19,549   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Income Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

     $949,914         $10,224,619       $ 9,937,336       $ 10,213,556   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended  

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser      May 31, 2009*  

International Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 7,487       $ 69,573       $ 20,485   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 25,747       $ 124,507       $ 142,545   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year  Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

High Yield Municipal Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 524,787       $ 2,361,306       $ 2,421,629       $ 3,036,689   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,883,799       $ 7,793,816       $ 6,138,109       $ 7,336,126   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

Balanced Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 516,594       $ 875,889       $ 884,961       $ 1,038,397   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

62


Table of Contents
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

Mid Cap Growth Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,977,727       $ 5,939,170       $ 7,193,675       $ 11,479,270   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Growth Fund I

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,371,009       $ 4,158,194       $ 3,216,309       $ 2,697,664   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 109,017         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Investor Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,486,665       $ 3,136,677       $ 4,131,661       $ 6,613,337   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 407,410       $ 989,742       $ 1,606,165       $ 294,451   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

*

All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,110,310       $ 2,721,935       $ 3,104,656   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 318,233       $ 382,426       $ 411,079   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Dividend Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 8,227,244       $ 7,520,664       $ 7,151,747   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 791,034       $ 591,255       $ 725,253   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,877,711       $ 8,656,167       $ 9,179,749   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,382,545       $ 6,765,818       $ 9,376,432   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 462,542       $ 524,477       $ 588,869   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 157,165       $ 160,592       $ 158,586   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 686,031       $ 1,670,236       $ 2,487,144       $ 4,576,982   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

63


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for the Funds are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Leonard A. Aplet, CFA    Balanced Fund
Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I
Robert B. Cameron    Emerging Markets Fund

Catherine Stienstra

   Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund
Richard A. Carter    Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Wayne M. Collette, CFA   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Richard E. Dahlberg, CFA    Dividend Income Fund
Richard G. D’Auteuil    Small Cap Core Fund
Scott L. Davis    Dividend Income Fund
Peter R. Deininger    Large Cap Growth Fund
Chad H. Farrington, CFA    High Yield Municipal Fund
William Finan    U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Thomas M. Galvin, CFA    Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Emil A. Gjester    Strategic Investor Fund
Todd D. Herget    Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Jeffrey Hershey, CFA    Small Cap Core Fund
Michael E. Hoover    Energy and Natural Resources Fund
Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFM   

Emerging Markets Fund

Pacific/Asia Fund

Arthur J. Hurley, CFA    Real Estate Equity Fund
Orhan Imer, PhD, CFA    U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Jeremy Javidi, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I
Brian Lavin, CFA   

Balanced Fund

Corporate Income Fund

High Yield Opportunity Fund

Intermediate Bond Fund

Strategic Income Fund

Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Colin J. Lundgren, CFA    Strategic Income Fund
George J. Myers, CFA   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Brian D. Neigut   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Daisuke Nomoto, CMA (SAAJ)    Pacific/Asia Fund
Jonas Patrikson, CFA    Strategic Investor Fund
Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

Bond Fund

Corporate Income Fund

Intermediate Bond

Nicholas Pifer, CFA    International Bond Fund
Jennifer Ponce de Leon    High Yield Opportunity Fund
Guy W. Pope, CFA   

Balanced Fund

Contrarian Core Fund

Value and Restructuring Fund

 

64


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Alexander D. Powers   

Bond Fund

Intermediate Bond Fund

J. Nicholas Smith, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund
Ronald B. Stahl, CFA    Balanced Fund
Gene R. Tannuzzo, CFA    Strategic Income Fund
Mary-Ann Ward    Strategic Investor Fund
Michael T. Welter, CFA    Strategic Investor Fund
Dara J. White, CFA    Emerging Markets Fund
David J. Williams, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund
John T. Wilson, CFA    Large Cap Growth Fund
Michael Zazzarino   

Bond Fund

Intermediate Bond Fund

Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about each Fund’s portfolio manager(s) as of the end of the Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date including the number and amount of assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the portfolio manager(s) managed.

         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

         

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

Bond Fund    Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

5 RICs

3 other accounts

  

$5.65 billion

$850,000

   None    None    (1)
   Alexander D. Powers   

2 RICs

7 PIVs

17 other accounts

  

$2.79 billion

$2.1 billion

$1.1 billion

   None   

$10,001- $50,000a

$1- 10,000b

   (1)
   Michael Zazzarino   

5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  

$4.193 billion

$2.636 billion

$192.2 million

   None    None    (1)
Corporate Income Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA1   

2 RICs

1 PIV

4 other accounts

  

$2.92 billion

$9.56 million

$766.77 million

   None    None    (2)
   Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

4 RICs

3 other accounts

  

$5.1 billion

$850,000

   None    None    (1)
Emerging Markets Fund    Robert B. Cameron   

1 PIV

5 other accounts

  

$61.4 million

$930,000

   None    $1- $10,000b    (1)
   Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFM   

7 RICs

4 PIVs

4 other accounts

  

$646.2 million

$634.7 million

$200,000

   None    None    (1)
   Dara J. White, CFA   

1 PIV

9 other accounts

  

$61.4 million

$405,000

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$10,001- $50,000b

   (1)
Energy and Natural Resources Fund    Michael E. Hoover   

3 PIVs

3 other accounts

  

$689.7 million

$741,342

   None    None    (1)
Intermediate Bond Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA1   

2 RICs

1 PIV

4 other accounts

  

$2.92 billion

$9.56 million

$766.77 million

   None    None    (2)

 

65


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

         

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
   Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

4 RICs

3 other accounts

  

$3.45 billion

$850,000

   None    $50,001- $100,000a    (1)
   Alexander D. Powers   

3 RICs

7 PIVs

17 other accounts

  

$3.4 billion

$2.1 billion

$1.1 billion

   None    None    (1)
   Michael Zazzarino   

5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  

$2.61 billion

$2.64 billion

$192.2 million

   None    None    (1)
Pacific/Asia Fund    Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFM   

7 RICs

4 PIVs

4 other accounts

  

$1.02 billion

$634.7 million

$200,000

   None    None    (1)
   Daisuke Nomoto, CMA (SAAJ)   

4 RICs

3 PIVs

2 other accounts

  

$490.8 million

$578.7 million

$200,000

   None    None    (1)
Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Richard A. Carter   

1 RIC

1 PIV

2,389 other accounts

  

$4 million

$43 million

$1.5 billion

   1 Other ($175 M)   

$50,001- $100,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)
   Thomas M. Galvin, CFA   

1 RIC

1 PIV

2,389 other accounts

  

$4 million

$43 million

$1.5 billion

   1 Other ($175 M)    Over $1,000,000    (1)
   Todd D. Herget   

1 PIV

2,389 other accounts

  

$43 million

$1.5 billion

   1 Other ($175 M)    $50,001- $100,000a    (1)
U.S. Treasury Index Fund    William Finan    5 other accounts    $1 million    None    None    (1)
   Orhan Imer, PhD, CFA    6 other accounts    $150,000    None    None    (1)
Value and Restructuring Fund    Guy W. Pope, CFA   

5 RICs

1,927 other accounts

  

$1.76 billion

$2.29 billion

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)
   J. Nicholas Smith, CFA   

3 RICs

1,883 other accounts

  

$924.6 million

$2.01 billion

   None    $10,001- $50,000a    (1)
   David J. Williams, CFA   

3 RICs

1,919 other accounts

  

$924.6 million

$2.08 billion

   None    $100,001- $500,000a    (1)

For Funds with fiscal year ending May 31

High Yield Opportunity Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA   

12 RICs

1 PIV

3 other accounts

  

$10.312 billion

$9.331 million

$683.335 million

   None    None    (2)
   Jennifer Ponce de Leon   

12 RICs

1 PIV

27 other accounts

  

$17.640 billion

$9.331 million

$4.578 million

   None    None    (2)
International Bond Fund    Nicholas Pifer, CFA2   

5 RICs

4 PIV

17 other accounts

  

$5.05 billion

$113.33 million

$4.62 billion

   None    None    (2)
Strategic Income Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA   

12 RICs

1 PIV

3 other accounts

  

$8.61 billion

$9.331 million

$683.335 million

   None    None    (2)
   Colin J. Lundgren, CFA   

21 RICs

9 other accounts

  

$40.761 billion

$274.15 million

  

2 RICs

($527.4 M)

   None    (2)
   Gene R. Tannuzzo, CFA   

10 RICs

2 other accounts

  

$25.657 billion

$0.08 million

   None       (2)

 

66


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

         

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)

For Funds with fiscal year ending June 30

High Yield Municipal Fund    Chad H. Farrington    8 other accounts    $194,000    None    $1-$10,000b    (1)
Small Cap Value Fund I    Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA   

5 RICs

1 PIV

13 other accounts

  

$433 million

$30 million

$57 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$10,001 - $50,000b

   (1)
   Jeremy Javidi, CFA   

5 RICs

1 PIV

14 other accounts

  

$433 million

$30 million

$54 million

   None   

$100,001- $500,000a

$1 - $10,000b

   (1)

For Funds with fiscal year ending August 31

Balanced Fund    Leonard A. Aplet, CFA   

10 RICs

8 PIVs

85 other accounts

  

$2.8 billion

$3.555 billion

$10.9 billion

   None    $10,001 - $50,000 a    (1)
   Brian Lavin, CFA   

12 RICs

1 PIV

3 other accounts

  

$9.907 billion

$10.48 million

$684.84 million

   None    None    (2)
   Guy W. Pope, CFA   

4 RICs

1,825 other accounts

  

$6.976 billion

$1.007 billion

   None    $100,001 - $500,000 a    (1)
   Ronald B. Stahl, CFA   

10 RICs

6 PIVs

53 other accounts

  

$2.8 billion

$785.7 million

$3.879 billion

   None    $10,001 - $50,000 a    (1)
Mid Cap Growth Fund    Wayne M. Collette, CFA   

9 RICs

2 PIVs

191 other accounts

  

$1.5 billion

$168.61 million

$240 million

   None    $10,001 - $50,000b    (1)
   Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.178 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None    $1- $10,000    (1)
   George J. Myers, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

182 other accounts

  

$1.178 billion

$168.61 million

$178.6 million

   None   

$10,001 - $50,000 a

$10,001 - $50,000 b

   (1)
   Brian D. Neigut   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.178 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)
Small Cap Growth Fund I    Wayne M. Collette, CFA   

9 RICs

2 PIVs

191 other accounts

  

$1.8 billion

$168.61 million

$240 million

   None    $10,001 - $50,000b    (1)
   Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.479 billion

$168.61 million

$178.8 million

   None    $1- $10,000    (1)
   George J. Myers, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

182 other accounts

  

$1.479 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None   

$10,001 - $50,000 a

$10,001 - $50,000 b

   (1)
   Brian D. Neigut   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.479 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)

 

67


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

           

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
 
Strategic Investor Fund    Emil A. Gjester   

1 RIC

1 PIV

289 other accounts

  

$89.65 million

$201.32 million

$220.38 million

   None   

$100,001 - $500,000 a

$10,001 - $50,000 b

     (1)   
   Jonas Patrikson, CFA   

1 RIC

1 PIV

282 other accounts

  

$89.648 million

$201.32 million

$220.22 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1-$10,000b

     (1)   
   Mary-Ann Ward   

1 RIC

1 PIV

293 other accounts

  

$89.65 million

$201.32 million

$227.68 million

   None    None      (1)   
   Michael T. Welter, CFA   

1 RIC

1 PIV

283 other accounts

  

89.65 billion

$201.3 million

$220.6 million

   None   

$50,001- $100,000a

$1 - $10,000b

     (1)   

For Funds with fiscal year ending September 30

  
Contrarian Core Fund    Guy W. Pope, CFA   

3 RICs

1,847 other accounts

  

$6.6 billion

$567 million

   None   

$100,001- $500,000a

$10,001- $50,000b

     (1)   
Dividend Income Fund    Richard E. Dahlberg, CFA   

1 RIC

2 PIVs

99 other accounts

  

$425 million

$372 million

$813.01 million

   None   

$100,001- $500,000a

$100,001- $500,000b

     (1)   
   Scott L. Davis   

2 PIVs

92 other accounts

  

$372 million

$815 million

   None   

$50,001- $100,000a

$100,001- $500,000b

     (1)   
Large Cap Growth Fund    Peter R. Deininger3   

1 PIV

15 other accounts

  

$315 million

$275 million

   None    $1- $10,000      (1)   
   John T. Wilson, CFA   

4 RICs

1 PIV

19 other accounts

  

$200 million

$300 million

$500 million

   None    $100,001- $500,000a      (1)   
Small Cap Core Fund    Richard D’Auteuil   

1 PIV

27 other accounts

  

$158.85 million

$907.08 million

   None    None      (1)   
   Jeffrey Hershey, CFA   

1 PIV

28 other accounts

  

$158.85 million

$901.77 million

   None    None      (1)   

For the Fund with fiscal year ending October 31

  
Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund    Catherine Stienstra4   

11 RICs

12 other accounts

  

$4.42 billion

$6.68 billion

   None    None      (2)   

For the Fund with fiscal period ending December 31

  
Real Estate Equity Fund    Arthur J. Hurley, CFA    8 other accounts    $750,000    None   

$1-$10,000a

$1-$10,000b

     (1)   

 

*

RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.

a

Excludes any notional investments.

b

Notional investments through a deferred compensation account.

1

Information provided as of April 30, 2010.

2

Account information provided as of May 31, 2010. Other accounts also include personal accounts as of June 30, 2010.

3

Account information provided as of March 31, 2010.

4

Account information provided as of August 31, 2010.

 

68


Table of Contents

 

Structure of Compensation

(1) Compensation of Legacy Columbia Management Advisors, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of the Previous Adviser prior to May 1, 2010, is typically paid in the form of salary, bonus, stock options, restricted stock and notional investments through an incentive plan, the value of which is measured by reference to the performance of the Columbia Funds in which the account is invested. The bonus for these portfolio managers is variable and generally is based on (1) an evaluation of the portfolio manager’s investment performance and (2) the results of a peer and/or management review of the portfolio manager, which takes into account skills and attributes such as team participation, investment process, communication and professionalism. In evaluating investment performance, the Adviser generally considers the one, three and five year performance of mutual funds and other accounts managed by the portfolio manager relative to the benchmarks and peer groups noted below, emphasizing the portfolio manager’s three and five year performance. The Adviser also may consider a portfolio manager’s performance in managing client assets in sectors and industries assigned to the portfolio manager as part of his/her investment team responsibilities, when applicable. For portfolio managers who also have group management responsibilities, another factor in their evaluation is an assessment of the group’s overall investment performance. The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

(2) Compensation of Legacy RiverSource Investments, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of RiverSource Investments, LLC (now known as Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC), is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, and (ii) an annual cash bonus, a portion of which may be subject to a mandatory deferral program, and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The Adviser’s portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Adviser employees. Depending upon their job level, Adviser portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Adviser employees at the same job level.

The annual cash bonus is paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by the aggregate market competitive bonus targets for the teams of which the portfolio manager is a member and by the short-term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to applicable benchmarks or the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of the Adviser has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team.

The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

 

69


Table of Contents

 

Performance Benchmarks

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Leonard A. Aplet,

CFA

   Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Classification

Catherine Stienstra

   Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund    Barclays Capital Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Connecticut Municipal Debt Funds Classification
Robert B. Cameron    Emerging Markets Fund    MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Net); MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Gross); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Classification
Richard A. Carter    Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Wayne M. Collette, CFA    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Richard E. Dahlberg, CFA    Dividend Income Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Equity Income Funds Classification
Richard D’Auteuil    Small Cap Core Fund    Russell 2000 Index; S&P Small Cap 600 Composite Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification
Scott L. Davis    Dividend Income Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Equity Income Funds Classification
Peter R. Deininger    Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Chad H. Farrington    High Yield Municipal Fund    Barclays Capital High Yield Municipal Bond Index; Blended Benchmark4    Lipper High Yield Municipal Debt Funds Classification
William Finan    U.S. Treasury Index Fund    Citigroup Bond U.S. Treasury Index    Lipper General U.S. Treasury Funds Classification
Thomas M. Galvin, CFA    Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

70


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Emil A. Gjester    Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
Todd D. Herget    Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Jeffrey Hershey, CFA    Small Cap Core Fund    Russell 2000 Index; S&P Small Cap 600 Composite Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification
Michael E. Hoover    Energy and Natural Resources Fund    S&P North American Natural Resources Sector Index    Lipper Natural Resources Funds Classification
Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFA    Emerging Markets Fund    MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Net); MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Gross); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Classification
   Pacific/Asia Fund    MSCI AC Asia Pacific Index (Net); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Pacific Region Funds Classification
Arthur J. Hurley, CFA    Real Estate Equity Fund    FTSE NAREIT Equity REITs Index    Lipper Real Estate Funds Classification
Orhan Imer    U.S. Treasury Index Fund    Citigroup Bond U.S. Treasury Index    Lipper General U.S. Treasury Funds Classification
Jeremy Javidi, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Classification
Brian Lavin, CFA    Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   Corporate Income Fund   

Barclays Capital Credit Bond Index;

Blended Benchmark2

   Lipper Corporate Debt Funds BBB Rated Classification
   High Yield Opportunity Fund    JPMorgan Global High Yield Index; Credit Suisse High Yield Index   

Lipper High Current Yield

Funds Classification

   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification
   Strategic Income Fund    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index; Blended Benchmark3    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification
Lawrence W. Lin, CFA    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

71


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Colin J. Lundgren, CFA    Strategic Income Fund    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index; Blended Benchmark3    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification
George J. Myers, CFA    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Brian D. Neigut    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Daisuke Nomoto, CMA (SAAJ)    Pacific/Asia Fund    MSCI AC Asia Pacific Index (Net); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Pacific Region Funds Classification
Carl. W. Pappo, CFA    Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Corporate Debt Funds A Rated Classification
   Corporate Income Fund   

Barclays Capital Credit Bond Index;

Blended Benchmark2

   Lipper Corporate Debt Funds BBB Rated Classification
   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification
Jonas Patrikson, CFA    Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
Nicholas Pifer    International Bond Fund    Citigroup Non-U.S. Dollar World Government Bond Index- Unhedged    Lipper International Income Funds Classification
Jennifer Ponce de Leon    High Yield Opportunity Fund    JPMorgan Global High Yield Index; Credit Suisse High Yield Index   

Lipper High Current Yield

Funds Classification

Guy W. Pope, CFA    Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification

 

72


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   Contrarian Core Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Value and Restructuring Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index; S&P 500 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification
Alexander D. Powers    Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Corporate Debt Funds A Rated Classification
   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification
J. Nicholas Smith, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index; S&P 500 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification
Ronald B. Stahl, CFA    Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
Gene R. Tannuzzo, CFA    Strategic Income Fund    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index; Blended Benchmark3    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification
Mary-Ann Ward    Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Michael T. Welter,

CFA

   Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
Dara J. White   

Emerging Markets

Fund

   MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Net); MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Gross); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Classification
David J. Williams, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index; S&P 500 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification
John T. Wilson, CFA    Large Cap Growth Fund   

Russell 1000 Growth

Index

   Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Michael Zazzarino    Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Corporate Debt Funds A Rated Classification
   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

 

1

A custom composite, established by the Adviser, consisting of a 60% weighting of the S&P 500 Index and a 40% weighting of the Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index.

2

A weighted custom composite of the Barclays Capital U.S. Credit Bond Index (85%) and JP Morgan Global High Yield Index (15%) established by the Adviser.

3

A custom composite, established by the Adviser, consisting of a 35% weighting of the Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index, a 35% weighting of the JPMorgan Global High Yield Index, a 15% weighting of the Citigroup Non-U.S. World Government Bond Index – Unhedged and a 15% weighting of the JPMorgan EMBI Global Diversified Index.

4

A custom composite, established by the Adviser, consisting of a 60% weighting of the Barclays Capital High Yield Municipal Bond Index and a 40% weighting of the Barclays Capital Municipal Bond Index.

 

73


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

Like other investment professionals with multiple clients, a Fund’s portfolio manager(s) may face certain potential conflicts of interest in connection with managing both the Fund and other accounts at the same time. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance policies and procedures that attempt to address certain of the potential conflicts that portfolio managers face in this regard. Certain of these conflicts of interest are summarized below.

The management of accounts with different advisory fee rates and/or fee structures, including accounts that pay advisory fees based on account performance (performance fee accounts), may raise potential conflicts of interest for a portfolio manager by creating an incentive to favor higher fee accounts.

Potential conflicts of interest also may arise when a portfolio manager has personal investments in other accounts that may create an incentive to favor those accounts. As a general matter and subject to the Adviser’s Code of Ethics and certain limited exceptions, the Adviser’s investment professionals do not have the opportunity to invest in client accounts, other than the Funds. A portfolio manager who is responsible for managing multiple funds and/or accounts may devote unequal time and attention to the management of those funds and/or accounts. The effects of this potential conflict may be more pronounced where funds and/or accounts managed by a particular portfolio manager have different investment strategies.

A portfolio manager may be able to select or influence the selection of the broker/dealers that are used to execute securities transactions for the Funds. A portfolio manager’s decision as to the selection of broker/dealers could produce disproportionate costs and benefits among the Funds and the other accounts the portfolio manager manages.

A potential conflict of interest may arise when a portfolio manager buys or sells the same securities for a Fund and other accounts. On occasions when a portfolio manager considers the purchase or sale of a security to be in the best interests of a Fund as well as other accounts, the Adviser’s trading desk may, to the extent consistent with applicable laws and regulations, aggregate the securities to be sold or bought in order to obtain the best execution and lower brokerage commissions, if any. Aggregation of trades may create the potential for unfairness to a Fund or another account if a portfolio manager favors one account over another in allocating the securities bought or sold.

“Cross trades,” in which a portfolio manager sells a particular security held by a Fund to another account (potentially saving transaction costs for both accounts), could involve a potential conflict of interest if, for example, a portfolio manager is permitted to sell a security from one account to another account at a higher price than an independent third party would pay. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance procedures that provide that any transactions between the Fund and another account managed by the Adviser are to be made at a current market price, consistent with applicable laws and regulations.

Another potential conflict of interest may arise based on the different investment objectives and strategies of a Fund and other accounts managed by its portfolio manager(s). Depending on another account’s objectives and other factors, a portfolio manager may give advice to and make decisions for a Fund that may differ from advice given, or the timing or nature of decisions made, with respect to another account. A portfolio manager’s investment decisions are the product of many factors in addition to basic suitability for the particular account involved. Thus, a portfolio manager may buy or sell a particular security for certain accounts, and not for a Fund, even though it could have been bought or sold for the Fund at the same time. A portfolio manager also may buy a particular security for one or more accounts when one or more other accounts are selling the security (including short sales). There may be circumstances when a portfolio manager’s purchases or sales of portfolio securities for one or more accounts may have an adverse effect on other accounts, including the Funds.

A Fund’s portfolio manager(s) also may have other potential conflicts of interest in managing the Fund, and the description above is not a complete description of every conflict that could exist in managing the Fund and

 

74


Table of Contents

other accounts. Many of the potential conflicts of interest to which the Adviser’s portfolio managers are subject are essentially the same or similar to the potential conflicts of interest related to the investment management activities of the Adviser and its affiliates. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

Manager of Managers Exemption

The SEC has issued an order that permits the Adviser, subject to the approval of the Board, to appoint an unaffiliated subadviser or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for a Fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits a Fund to add or to change unaffiliated subadvisers or to change the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change. The Adviser and its affiliates may have other relationships, including significant financial relationships, with current or potential subadvisers or their affiliates, which may create certain conflicts of interest. When making recommendations to the Board to appoint or to change a subadviser, or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement, the Adviser discloses to the Board the nature of any material relationships it has with a subadviser or its affiliates.

The Administrator

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (which is also the Adviser) serves as Administrator of the Funds.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator has agreed to provide all of the services and facilities necessary for, or appropriate to, the business and effective operation of each Fund that are not (a) provided by employees or other agents engaged by each Fund or (b) required to be provided by any person pursuant to any other agreement or arrangement with each Fund.

Administration Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

The Administrator receives fees as compensation for its services, which are computed daily and paid monthly, as set forth in the Administrative Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Primary Service Providers – The Administrator in each Fund’s prospectuses.

For U.S. Treasury Index Fund, pursuant to the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator, from the administration fee it receives from the Fund, pays all operating expenses of the Fund, except the fees and expenses of the Trustees who are not interested persons of the Administrator or its affiliates, brokerage fees and commissions, interest on borrowings and such extraordinary, non-recurring expenses as may arise, including litigation expenses. For the purposes of this arrangement, distribution and service fees are not considered operating expenses.

Administration Fees Paid by the Funds

The Administrator and the Previous Administrator received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show administration fees paid to and, as applicable, waived/reimbursed by the Administrator and the Previous Administrator, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

75


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 754,748       $ 678,588       $ 759,720   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 209,350       $ 206,179   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 675,315       $ 675,654       $ 870,923   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 615,027       $ 1,001,669       $ 2,430,055   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 251,476       $ 476,664   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 723,263       $ 765,650       $ 941,122   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 254,984       $ 263,577   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 3,164,565       $ 3,373,301       $ 3,620,050   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 16,020       $ 85,238       $ 334,900   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 30,445       $ 66,921   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,127,779       $ 1,291,853       $ 1,216,720   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 394,599       $ 333,294   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,122,055       $ 1,080,502       $ 551,345   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 9,398,359       $ 11,411,391       $ 13,588,716   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 3,327,593       $ 3,424,080   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
       

High Yield Opportunity Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Income Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

76


Table of Contents

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended
May 31, 2009*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
    

International Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

     $680         $6,325       $ 1,862   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
       

High Yield Municipal Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 140,597       $ 637,176       $ 661,657       $ 815,422   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
       

Balanced Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Mid Cap Growth Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Growth Fund I

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Investor Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     $382,478         $810,252       $ 1,058,644       $ 1,175,452   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.
1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 201,987       $ 260,528       $ 297,160   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

77


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Dividend Income Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 836,788       $ 756,060       $ 714,875   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 555,279       $ 865,130       $ 922,750   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 302,523       $ 625,431       $ 889,186   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

     N/A         N/A         N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     N/A         N/A         N/A   

Amount Waived

     N/A         N/A         N/A   

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

State Street is responsible for providing certain pricing and bookkeeping services to the Funds. The Administrator is responsible for overseeing the performance of these services and for certain other services.

Services Provided

Effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into a Financial Reporting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (the Financial Reporting Services Agreement) pursuant to which State Street provides financial reporting services to the Funds. Also effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into an Accounting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (collectively with the Financial Reporting Services Agreement, the State Street Agreements) pursuant to which State Street provides accounting services to the Funds. Effective May 1, 2010, the State Street Agreements were amended to, among other things, assign and delegate the Previous Adviser’s rights and obligations under the State Street Agreements to the Administrator. Under the State Street Agreements, each Fund pays State Street an annual fee of $38,000 paid monthly plus an additional monthly fee based on an annualized percentage rate of average daily net assets of the Fund for the month. The aggregate fee for a Fund during any year shall not exceed $140,000 annually (exclusive of out-of-pocket expenses and charges). Each Fund also reimburses State Street for certain out-of-pocket expenses and charges.

 

78


Table of Contents

 

From December 15, 2006 through May 1, 2010, the Trust was party to a Pricing and Bookkeeping Oversight and Services Agreement (the Services Agreement) with the Previous Adviser. Under the Services Agreement, the Previous Adviser provided services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and provided oversight of the accounting and financial reporting services provided by State Street. Under the Services Agreement, each Fund reimbursed the Previous Adviser for out-of-pocket expenses and charges, including fees payable to third parties, such as for pricing the Funds’ portfolio securities, incurred by the Previous Adviser in the performance of services under the Services Agreement. Prior to January 1, 2008, the Funds also reimbursed the Previous Adviser for accounting oversight services and services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Effective May 1, 2010, the services previously provided by the Previous Adviser under the Services Agreement began to be provided by the Administrator under the Administrative Services Agreement, and the Services Agreement was terminated. Under the Administrative Services Agreement, fees for pricing and bookkeeping services incurred by U.S. Treasury Index Fund are paid by the Administrator.

Prior to December 15, 2006, the Previous Adviser was responsible for providing pricing and bookkeeping services, to the Funds operating at the time, under a pricing and bookkeeping agreement and was entitled to receive an annual fee at the same rate described above under the State Street Agreements. Under separate agreements between the Previous Adviser and State Street, the Previous Adviser delegated certain functions to State Street. As a result of the delegation, the total fees payable under the pricing and bookkeeping agreement (other than certain reimbursements paid to the Previous Adviser and discussed below) were paid to State Street. The Funds also reimbursed the Previous Adviser for out-of-pocket expenses and charges, including fees payable to third parties for pricing the Funds’ portfolio securities and direct internal costs incurred by the Previous Adviser in connection with providing fund accounting oversight and monitoring and certain other services.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Fees Paid by the Funds

The Adviser and the Previous Adviser and State Street received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show the net pricing and bookkeeping fees paid to State Street and to the Adviser and the Previous Adviser, as applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 149,216       $ 129,842       $ 82,648   

Corporate Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,791   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 158,268       $ 156,839       $ 182,251   

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 103,288       $ 117,814       $ 105,826   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 123,403       $ 116,154       $ 78,072   

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,791   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 189,677       $ 188,898       $ 189,435   

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 53,504       $ 57,548       $ 52,002   

 

79


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 140,511       $ 140,065       $ 77,132   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund**

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 143,767       $ 143,296       $ 78,208   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.
** Under the Administrative Services Agreement, fees for pricing and bookkeeping services incurred by U.S. Treasury Index Fund are paid by the Administrator.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 114,926   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 113,154       $ 96,616       $ 8,212   

Strategic Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 190,423   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 193,287       $ 181,682       $ 8,212   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended
May 31, 2009*
 

International Bond Fund

     

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 46,735       $ 26,617   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 7,494   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 192,931       $ 180,290       $ 191,877   

Small Cap Value Fund I

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 7,494   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 146,364       $ 145,161       $ 143,111   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Balanced Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

     $97,492       $ 80,304       $ 85,084   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 145,095       $ 145,117       $ 144,122   

 

80


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Small Cap Growth Fund I

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 145,808       $ 97,227       $ 87,811   

Strategic Investor Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 147,864       $ 143,423       $ 149,889   

 

*

All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 43,283   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 83,251       $ 96,037       $ 78,321   

Dividend Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 51,635   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,429       $ 144,517       $ 103,692   

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 51,635   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,538       $ 140,096       $ 106,855   

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 51,635   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 104,080       $ 152,060       $ 114,670   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 1,952       $ 24,798   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 61,643       $ 62,893       $ 56,215   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673       $ 63,096   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 27,743       $ 74,509       $ 84,454       $ 84,836   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (the Distributor) serves as the principal underwriter and distributor for the continuous offering of shares of the Funds pursuant to a Distribution Agreement. The Distribution Agreement obligates the Distributor to use appropriate efforts to find purchasers for the shares of the Funds. The Distributor’s address is: One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111.

Distribution Obligations

Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, as agent, sells shares of the Funds on a continuous basis and transmits purchase and redemption orders that it receives to the Trust or the Transfer Agent, or their

 

81


Table of Contents

designated agents. Additionally, the Distributor has agreed to use appropriate efforts to solicit orders for the sale of shares and to undertake advertising and promotion as it believes appropriate in connection with such solicitation. Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, at its own expense, finances those activities which are primarily intended to result in the sale of shares of the Funds, including, but not limited to, advertising, compensation of underwriters, dealers and sales personnel, the printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than existing shareholders, and the printing and mailing of sales literature. The Distributor, however, may be compensated or reimbursed for all or a portion of such expenses to the extent permitted by a Distribution Plan adopted by the Trust pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Distribution and Servicing Plans for more information about the share classes for which the Trust has adopted a Distribution Plan.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

The Distribution Agreement became effective with respect to each Fund after approval by its Board, and, after an initial two-year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Distribution Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Distribution Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to each Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Distributor on 60 days’ written notice.

Underwriting Commissions Paid by the Funds

The Distributor and the Previous Distributor received commissions and other compensation for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show amounts paid to the Distributor and the Previous Distributor, as well as amounts the Distributor and Previous Distributor retained, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 87,653       $ 23,344         —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 10,847       $ 3,032         —     

Class C shares

   $ 813         —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 76,987       $ 42,265       $ 83,846   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 8,679       $ 4,859       $ 10,209   

Class B shares

   $ 6,890       $ 19,621       $ 26,159   

Class C shares

   $ 1,744       $ 1,809       $ 4,085   

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 71,380       $ 25,581       $ 15,743   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 11,618       $ 4,445       $ 5,464   

Class C shares

   $ 134       $ 356       $ 117   

 

82


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 367,133       $ 226,149       $ 41,980   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 55,189       $ 37,467       $ 6,898   

Class C shares

   $ 4,646       $ 5,557         —     

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 100,659       $ 75,693       $ 164,058   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 9,832       $ 9,783       $ 17,512   

Class B shares

   $ 20,653       $ 67,508       $ 126,025   

Class C shares

   $ 3,191       $ 13,915       $ 3,509   

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 4,028       $ 1,037         —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 576       $ 109         —     

Class C shares

   $ 28         —           —     

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 72,757       $ 35,906       $ 17,771   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 11,067       $ 22,304       $ 2,508   

Class C shares

   $ 1,504       $ 1,487         —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 83,413       $ 599,674       $ 32,972   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 9,858       $ 68,225       $ 4,014   

Class B shares

   $ 20,761       $ 19,230       $ 7,255   

Class C shares

   $ 45,774       $ 36,124       $ 2,579   

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 323,994       $ 1,456,148       $ 475,597   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 54,926       $ 327,389       $ 81,037   

Class C shares

   $ 22,254       $ 53,825       $ 1,095   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

  
Distributor
     Previous
Distributor
       

High Yield Opportunity Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 2,214       $ 102,312       $ 52,757       $ 81,858   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

     $12,953**       $ 6,397       $ 9,712   

Class B shares

     $12,197**       $ 37,832       $ 120,102   

Class C shares

     $1,882**       $ 2,372       $ 1,294   

 

83


Table of Contents
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

  
Distributor
     Previous
Distributor
       

Strategic Income Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 62,252       $ 1,393,488       $ 1,484,623       $ 1,500,658   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

     $212,105**       $ 174,597       $ 182,191   

Class B shares

     $112,534**       $ 254,576       $ 401,532   

Class C shares

     $ 55,451**       $ 38,358       $ 16,683   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
 

Fund

   Distributor      Previous
Distributor
    

International Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $  532       $  7,025       $ 5   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     $ 869**       $ 1   

Class C shares

     $     4**         —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

Fund

  
Distributor
     Previous
Distributor
       

High Yield Municipal Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A Shares

     $14,851         $76,842         $62,416         $79,171   

Amount Retained

           

Class A Shares

     $10,473**        
 
 
 
$7,933
(underwriting
discount)
$33 (CDSC)
  
  
  
  
    
 
 
 
$9,673
(underwriting
discounts)
$12,689 (CDSC)
  
  
  
  

Class B Shares

     $8,610**         $16,011         $23,627   

Class C Shares

     $2,743**         $736         $4,765   

Small Cap Value Fund I

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $26,259         $154,679         $253,305         $350,124   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

     $28,705**        

 
 

 

$40,492

(underwriting
discount)

$519 (CDSC)

  

  
  

  

    
 
 
 
$54,614
(underwriting
discounts)
$1,051 (CDSC)
  
  
  
  

Class B shares

     $36,729**         $69,591         $95,335   

Class C shares

     $5,331**         $7,107         $16,400   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.

 

84


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 
      Distributor      Previous
Distributor
               

Balanced Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $207,936         $337,368         $134,794         $51,909   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

  

 


$81,893**


  


     $19,807        
 
 
$10,387
(underwriting
discount)
  
  
  

Class B shares

  

 

$10,629**

  

     $9,543         $8,501   

Class C shares

  

 

$7,621**

  

     $423         $94   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $19,121         $32,841         $51,601         $180,381   

Class T shares

     $156         $372         $917         $1,016   

Amount Retained

           

Class A Retained

  

 

$7,346**

  

     $7,987         $35,837   

Class B Retained

  

 

$4,870**

  

     $9,579         $12,057   

Class C Retained

  

 

$1,021**

  

     $1,459         $3,558   

Class T Retained

  

 

$61**

  

             $1   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $27,242         $55,837         $101,052         $187,929   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

  

 

$11,901**

  

     $17,113         $30,175   

Class B shares

  

 

$5,690**

  

     $4,599         $1,789   

Class C shares

  

 

$2,854**

  

     $13,038         $1,464   

Strategic Investor Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $16,138         $42,407         $76,883         $209,325   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

  

 

$8,700**

  

     $12,250         $241,215   

Class B shares

  

 

$29,424**

  

     $70,039         $83,980   

Class C shares

  

 

$2,257**

  

     $2,303         $4,702   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.
1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     $86,071         $36,936         $19,479   

Class T shares

     $12,088         $28,049         $27,371   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     $12,921        
 
 

 

$6,075
(underwriting
discount)

$11 (CDSC)

  
  
  

  

    
 
 

 

$3,232
(underwriting
discount)

$26 (CDSC)

  
  
  

  

Class B shares

     $4,070         $6,252         $13,877   

Class C shares

     $442         $217         $56   

Class T shares

     $1,659        
 
 
 
$4,121
(underwriting
discount)
— (CDSC)
  
  
 
  
    
 
 
$3,847
(underwriting
discount)
  
  
  

 

85


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*

Dividend Income Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $803,682    $286,403    $488,144

Class T shares

   $6,141    $8,615    $11,210

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $125,322    $48,889
(underwriting
discount)

$347 (CDSC)

   $84,117
(underwriting
discount)

$91 (CDSC)

Class B shares

   $39,378    $46,255    $62,830

Class C shares

   $5,857    $3,049    $8,381

Class T shares

   $930    $1,246
(underwriting
discount)
   $1,438
(underwriting
discount)

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $74,526    $98,167    $92,402

Class T shares

   $41,614    $65,452    $55,772

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $18,305    $15,920
(underwriting
discount)

$795 (CDSC)

   $15,320
(underwriting
discount)

$624 (CDSC)

Class B shares

   $33,744    $88,380    $160,928

Class C shares

   $2,549    $3,369    $3,244

Class E shares

   $87    — (underwriting
discount)

$75 (CDSC)

   —  

Class F shares

   N/A    N/A    —  

Class T shares

   $5,524    $8,731
(underwriting
discount)

$4,712 (CDSC)

   $7,274
(underwriting
discount)

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $65,118    $8,298    $24,792

Class T shares

   $10,735    $17,011    $23,624

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $9,774    $1,180
(underwriting
discount)

— (CDSC)

   $3,923
(underwriting
discount)

$3 (CDSC)

Class B shares

   $20,617    $59,022    $70,993

Class C shares

   $100    $339    $507

Class T shares

   $1,442    $2,334
(underwriting
discount)

$451 (CDSC)

   $2,756
(underwriting
discount)

—  

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

86


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     $81,306         $60,652         $36,337   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     $10,073        
 
 
$7,301
(underwriting
discount)
  
  
  
    
 
 
 
$3,961
(underwriting
discounts)
(CDSC)
  
  
  
  

Class B shares

     $5,835         $13,389         $29,439   

Class C shares

     $168         $467         $40   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 19,596       $ 27,222       $ 33,423       $ 120,365   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 3,518       $ 5,864       $ 6,160       $ 19,151   

Class B shares

   $ 2,585       $ 6,730       $ 12,250       $ 36,895   

Class C shares

   $ 431       $ 1,207       $ 1,701       $ 1,814   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

LOGO Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

As described above in the Investment Advisory and Other Services section of this SAI, and in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Adviser, Administrator, Distributor and Transfer Agent, all affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, receive compensation from the Funds for the various services they provide to the Funds. Additional information as to the specific terms regarding such compensation is set forth in these affiliated service providers’ contracts with the Funds, each of which typically is included as an exhibit to Part C of each Fund’s registration statement.

In many instances, the compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for the services they provide to the Funds is based, in some manner, on the size of the Funds’ assets under management. As the size of the Funds’ assets under management grows, so does the amount of compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for providing services to the Funds. This relationship between Fund assets and affiliated service provider compensation may create economic and other conflicts of interests of which Fund investors should be aware. These potential conflicts of interest, as well as additional ones, are discussed in detail below and also are addressed in other disclosure materials, including the Funds’ prospectuses. These conflicts of interest also are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials of Ameriprise Financial affiliates that make available or offer the Columbia Funds as investments in connection with their respective products and services. In addition, Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV, which it must file with the SEC as an investment adviser registered under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, provides information about the Adviser’s business, assets under management, affiliates and potential conflicts of interest. Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV is available online through the SEC’s website at www.adviserinfo.sec.gov.

Additional actual or potential conflicts of interest and certain investment activity limitations that could affect the Funds may arise from the financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including, for example, the investment advisory/management services provided for clients and customers other

 

87


Table of Contents

than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial is a major financial services company. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are engaged in a wide range of financial activities beyond the mutual fund-related activities of the Adviser, including, among others, broker/dealer (sales and trading), asset management, insurance and other financial activities. The broad range of financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may involve multiple advisory, transactional, lending, financial and other interests in securities and other instruments, and in companies, that may be bought, sold or held by the Funds. The following describes certain actual and potential conflicts of interest that may be presented.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to the Investment Advisory/Management Activities of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates in Connection With Other Advised/Managed Funds and Accounts

The Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may advise or manage funds and accounts other than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may provide investment advisory/management and other services to other advised/managed funds and accounts that are similar to those provided to the Funds. The Adviser and Ameriprise Financial’s other investment adviser affiliates (including, for example, Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC) will give advice to and make decisions for all advised/managed funds and accounts, including the Funds, as they believe to be in that fund’s and/or account’s best interests, consistent with their fiduciary duties. The Funds and the other advised/managed funds and accounts of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are separately and potentially divergently managed, and there is no assurance that any investment advice Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates give to other advised/managed funds and accounts will also be given simultaneously or otherwise to the Funds.

A variety of other actual and potential conflicts of interest may arise from the advisory relationships of the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates with other clients and customers. Advice given to the Funds and/or investment decisions made for the Funds by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may differ from, or may conflict with, advice given to and/or investment decisions made for other advised/managed funds and accounts. As a result, the performance of the Funds may differ from the performance of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. Similarly, a position taken by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, on behalf of other funds or accounts may be contrary to a position taken on behalf of the Funds. Moreover, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may take a position on behalf of other advised/managed funds and accounts, or for their own proprietary accounts, that is adverse to companies or other issuers in which the Funds are invested. For example, the Funds may hold equity securities of a company while another advised/managed fund or account may hold debt securities of the same company. If the portfolio company were to experience financial difficulties, it might be in the best interest of the Funds for the company to reorganize while the interests of the other advised/managed fund or account might be better served by the liquidation of the company. This type of conflict of interest could arise as the result of circumstances that cannot be generally foreseen within the broad range of investment advisory/management activities in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates engage.

Investment transactions made on behalf of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates also may have a negative effect on the value, price or investment strategies of the Funds. For example, this could occur if another advised/managed fund or account implements an investment decision ahead of, or at the same time as, the Funds and causes the Funds to experience less favorable trading results than they otherwise would have experienced based on market liquidity factors. In addition, the other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, including the other Columbia Funds, may have the same or very similar investment objective and strategies as the Funds. In this situation, the allocation of, and competition for, investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and/or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may create conflicts of interest especially where, for example, limited investment availability is involved. The Adviser has adopted policies and procedures addressing the allocation of investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and accounts advised by the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

 

88


Table of Contents

 

Sharing of Information among Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may possess information that could be material to the management of a Fund and may not be able to, or may determine not to, share that information with the Fund, even though the information might be beneficial to the Fund. This information may include actual knowledge regarding the particular investments and transactions of other advised/managed funds and accounts, as well as proprietary investment, trading and other market research, analytical and technical models, and new investment techniques, strategies and opportunities. Depending on the context, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will have no obligation to share any such information with the Funds. In general, employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the portfolio managers of the Adviser, will make investment decisions without regard to information otherwise known by other employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and generally will have no obligation to access any such information and may, in some instances, not be able to access such information because of legal and regulatory constraints or the internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For example, if the Adviser or another Ameriprise Financial affiliate, or their respective employees, come into possession of non-public information regarding another advised/managed fund or account, they may be prohibited by legal and regulatory constraints, or internal policies and procedures, from using that information in connection with transactions made on behalf of the Funds. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

Soft Dollar Benefits

Certain products and services, commonly referred to as “soft dollar services” (including, to the extent permitted by law, research reports, economic and financial data, financial publications, proxy analysis, computer databases and other research-oriented materials), that the Adviser may receive in connection with brokerage services provided to a Fund may have the inadvertent effect of disproportionately benefiting other advised/managed funds or accounts. This could happen because of the relative amount of brokerage services provided to a Fund as compared to other advised/managed funds or accounts, as well as the relative compensation paid by a Fund.

Services Provided to Other Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may act as an investment adviser, investment manager, administrator, transfer agent, custodian, trustee, broker/dealer, agent, or in another capacity, for advised/managed funds and accounts other than the Funds, and may receive compensation for acting in such capacity. This compensation that the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates receive could be greater than the compensation Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates receive for acting in the same or similar capacity for the Funds. In addition, the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may receive other benefits, including enhancement of new or existing business relationships. This compensation and/or the benefits that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may receive from other advised/managed funds and accounts and other relationships could potentially create incentives to favor other advised/managed funds and accounts over the Funds. Trades made by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates for the Funds may be, but are not required to be, aggregated with trades made for other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. If trades are aggregated among the Funds and those other funds and accounts, the various prices of the securities being traded may be averaged, which could have the potential effect of disadvantaging the Funds as compared to the other funds and accounts with which trades were aggregated.

Proxy Voting

Although the Adviser endeavors to make all proxy voting decisions with respect to the interests of the Funds for which it is responsible in accordance with its proxy voting policies and procedures, the Adviser’s proxy voting decisions with respect to a Fund’s portfolio securities may nonetheless benefit other advised/managed

 

89


Table of Contents

funds and accounts, and/or clients, of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. The Adviser has adopted proxy voting policies and procedures that are designed to provide that all proxy voting is done in the best interests of its clients, including the Funds, without any resulting benefit or detriment to the Adviser and/or its affiliates, including Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For more information about the Adviser’s proxy voting policies and procedures, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures.

Certain Trading Activities

The directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may buy and sell securities or other investments for their own accounts, and in doing so may take a position that is adverse to the Funds. In order to reduce the possibility that such personal investment activities of the directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates will materially adversely affect the Funds, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have adopted policies and procedures, and the Funds, the Board, the Adviser and the Distributor have each adopted a Code of Ethics that addresses such personal investment activities. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Codes of Ethics.

Affiliate Transactions

Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may enter into transactions in which Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates, or companies that are deemed to be affiliates of a Fund because of, among other factors, their or their affiliates’ ownership or control of shares of the Fund, may have an interest that potentially conflicts with the interests of the Fund. For example, an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial may sell securities to a Fund from an offering in which it is an underwriter or that it owns as a dealer, subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements. Applicable legal and regulatory requirements also may prevent a Fund from engaging in transactions with an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, or from participating in an investment opportunity in which an affiliate of a Fund participates.

Certain Investment Limitations

Regulatory and other restrictions may limit a Fund’s investment activities in various ways. For example, regulations regarding certain industries and markets, such as emerging or international markets, and certain transactions, such as those involving certain futures and derivatives as well as restrictions applicable to certain issuers (e.g., poison pills), may impose limits on the aggregate amount of investments that may be made by affiliated investors, including accounts owned or managed by the same or affiliated managers, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. In these circumstances, the Adviser may be prevented from acquiring securities for a Fund that it might otherwise prefer to acquire if the acquisition would cause the Fund and its affiliated investors to exceed an applicable limit. These types of regulatory and other applicable limits are complex and vary significantly in different contexts including, among others, from country to country, industry to industry and issuer to issuer. The Adviser has procedures in place designed to monitor potential conflicts arising from regulatory and other limits. Nonetheless, given the complexity of these limits, the Adviser and its affiliates may inadvertently breach these limits, and a Fund may therefore be required to sell securities that it might otherwise prefer to hold in order to comply with such limits. At certain times, a Fund may be restricted in its investment activities because of relationships that an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, may have with the issuers of securities. This could happen, for example, if a Fund desired to buy a security issued by a company for which Ameriprise Financial or an affiliate serves as underwriter. The internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates covering these types of restrictions and addressing similar issues also may at times restrict a Fund’s investment activities. See also About the Funds’ Investments – Certain Investment Activity Limits.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates’ Non-Advisory Relationships with Clients and Customers other than the Funds

The financial relationships that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may have with companies and other entities in which a Fund may invest can give rise to actual and potential conflicts of interest. Subject to applicable

 

90


Table of Contents

legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may invest (a) in the securities of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or in companies in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have an equity, debt or other interest, and/or (b) in the securities of companies held by other Columbia Funds. The purchase, holding and sale of such securities by a Fund may enhance the profitability and the business interests of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or other Columbia Funds. There also may be limitations as to the sharing with the Adviser of information derived from the non-investment advisory/management activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates because of legal and regulatory constraints and internal policies and procedures (such as information barriers and ethical walls). Because of these limitations, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will not share information derived from its non-investment advisory/management activities with the Adviser.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial Affiliates’ Marketing and Use of the Columbia Funds as Investment Options

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also provide a variety of products and services that, in some manner, may utilize the Columbia Funds as investment options. For example, the Columbia Funds may be offered as investments in connection with brokerage and other securities products offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and may be utilized as investments in connection with fiduciary, investment management and other accounts offered by affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, as well as for other Columbia Funds structured as “funds of funds.” The use of the Columbia Funds in connection with other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may introduce economic and other conflicts of interest. These conflicts of interest are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials for the other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates.

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may make payments to their affiliates in connection with the promotion and sale of the Funds’ shares, in addition to the sales-related and other compensation that these parties may receive from the Funds. As a general matter, personnel of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, do not receive compensation in connection with their sales or use of the Funds that is greater than that paid in connection with their sales of other comparable products and services. Nonetheless, because the compensation that the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may receive for providing services to the Funds is generally based on the Funds’ assets under management and those assets will grow as shares of the Funds are sold, potential conflicts of interest may exist. See Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Financial Intermediary Payments for more information.

Other Services Provided

The Transfer Agent

Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly, RiverSource Service Corporation) is the transfer agent for the Funds. The Transfer Agent is located at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111. Under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Transfer Agent provides transfer agency, dividend disbursing agency and shareholder servicing agency services to the Funds. Effective September 7, 2010, the Funds pay the Transfer Agent an annual transfer agency fee of $12.08 per account, payable monthly for all share classes, except for Class I shares, and, prior to September 7, 2010, paid the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) an annual transfer agency fee of $22.36 per account, payable monthly.

In addition, effective September 7, 2010, the Funds reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds in an annual amount equal to 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in such omnibus accounts (other than omnibus accounts for which American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc. is the broker of record or accounts where the beneficial owner is a customer of Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., for which the Transfer Agent is reimbursed $16.00 annually, calculated monthly based on the total number of positions in such accounts at the end of such month) for all share classes, except for Class I, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares. For Class R4 and Class R5 shares, the Funds reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds subject to an annual

 

91


Table of Contents

limitation of 0.05% of the net assets attributable to such shares. Prior to September 7, 2010, the Funds reimbursed the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent paid to financial intermediaries that maintained omnibus accounts with the Funds, subject to a cap of up to $22.36 per account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent on a per account basis and a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by such an account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent based on a percentage of net assets.

The Funds also pay certain reimbursable out-of-pocket expenses of the Transfer Agent. The Transfer Agent also may retain as additional compensation for its services revenues for fees for wire, telephone and redemption orders, IRA trustee agent fees and account transcripts due the Transfer Agent from Fund shareholders and credits (net of bank charges) earned with respect to balances in accounts the Transfer Agent maintains in connection with its services to the Funds.

For the period November 1, 2007 through October 31, 2009, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual transfer agency fee of $17.34 per account, payable monthly. In addition, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid for the fees and expenses the Previous Transfer Agent paid to third party dealer firms that maintained omnibus accounts with certain of the Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account. For the period April 1, 2006 through October 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual fee of $17.00 per account, payable monthly. For the period September 1, 2005 through October 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was entitled to reimbursement by certain Funds for the fees and expenses that the Previous Transfer Agent paid to dealer firms or transfer agents that maintained omnibus accounts with such Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.11% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account.

The Funds that offer Class R4 shares have a Plan Administration Services Agreement with the Transfer Agent. Under the agreement, the Funds pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and Health Savings Accounts (HSAs). The fee for services is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of the average daily net assets of each Fund attributable to Class R4 shares.

Transfer agency costs for each Fund are calculated separately for each of (i) Class Y shares, (ii) Class R4 and Class R5 shares and (iii) all other share classes (except Class I shares, which pay no transfer agency fees). Pursuant to the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator pays the Transfer Agency Fees of U.S. Treasury Index Fund on behalf of the Fund. The fees paid to the Transfer Agent may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval.

The Transfer Agent retains BFDS/DST, 2 Heritage Drive, North Quincy, MA 02171 as the Funds’ sub-transfer agent. BFDS/DST assists the Transfer Agent in carrying out its duties.

The Custodian

State Street, which is located at State Street Financial Center, One Lincoln Street, Boston, MA 02111, is the Funds’ Custodian. State Street is responsible for safeguarding the Funds’ cash and securities, receiving and delivering securities and collecting the Funds’ interest and dividends.

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, which is located at 125 High Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the Funds’ independent registered public accounting firm. The Funds issue unaudited financial statements semi-annually and audited financial statements annually. The financial statements for the fiscal years ended on or after August 31, 2009 contained in a Fund’s Annual Report were audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. The Board has selected PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as the independent registered public accounting firm to audit the Funds’ books and review their tax returns for the fiscal years ended on or after August 31, 2010.

 

92


Table of Contents

 

The Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements are included in the annual reports to shareholders of the Funds, and are incorporated herein by reference. No other parts of the annual reports or semi-annual reports to shareholders are incorporated by reference herein. The financial statements incorporated by reference into the Funds’ prospectuses and this SAI have been so incorporated in reliance upon the report of the independent registered public accounting firm, given on its authority as an expert in auditing and accounting.

Counsel

Ropes & Gray LLP serves as legal counsel to the Trust. Its address is One International Place, Boston, Massachusetts 02110. K&L Gates LLP serves as co-counsel. Its address is 1601 K Street N.W., Washington, DC, 20006-1600.

Distribution and Servicing Plans

The Trust has adopted distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans for the Class A shares, Class B shares, Class C shares, Class E shares, Class F shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares, Class T shares and Class W shares of the Funds. See Capital Stock and Other Securities for information about which Funds offer which classes of shares. The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, Class E shares, Class F shares or Class T shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in any such shares. See the prospectuses for these share classes of the Funds for details.

The table below shows the maximum annual distribution and/or services fees (payable monthly and calculated based on an annual percentage of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees applicable to each share class:

 

      Distribution
Fee
   Service
Fee
   Combined
Total

Class A

   up to 0.10%    0.25%    up to  0.35%a,b

Class B

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%b

Class C

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%b,c

Class E

   0.10%    0.25%    0.35%

Class F

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%

Class I

   none    none    none

Class R

   0.50%    —  d    0.50%

Class R4

   none    0.25%e    0.25%e

Class R5

   none    none    none

Class T

   none    0.50%f    0.50%f

Class W

   0.25%    0.25%    0.25%

Class Y

   none    none    none

Class Z

   none    none    none

 

a

As shown in the table below, the maximum distribution and service fees of Class A shares varies among the Funds.

 

Columbia funds

   Class A
Distribution
Fee
    Class A
Service
Fee
    Class A
Combined
Total
 

Balanced Fund, Contrarian Core Fund, Dividend Income Fund, Intermediate Bond Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, Mid Cap Growth Fund, Real Estate Equity Fund, Small Cap Core Fund, Small Cap Growth Fund I

     0.10     0.25     0.35 %* 

Bond Fund, Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Corporate Income Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, High Yield Opportunity Fund, International Bond Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, Small Cap Value Fund I, Strategic Income Fund, Strategic Investor Fund, U.S. Treasury Index Fund, Value and Restructuring Fund

     —          0.25     0.25

High Yield Municipal Fund

     —          0.20     0.20

 

* The indicated Funds may pay distribution and service fees up to a maximum of 0.35% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class A shares (comprised of up to 0.10% for distribution services and up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services) but currently limit such fees to an aggregate fee of not more than 0.25% for Class A shares.

 

93


Table of Contents
b

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.10% on net assets attributable to shares of the Fund issued prior to December 1, 1994, and 0.25% on net assets attributable to Fund shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.10% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2009, the blended service fee was 0.24% of the Fund’s average net assets. Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Strategic Income Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.15% on net assets attributable to shares of this Fund issued prior to January 1, 1993 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for all Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.15% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended May 31, 2010, the blended service fee was 0.25% of the Fund’s average net assets.

c

The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares of the following Funds so that the combined distribution and service fee (or the distribution fee for Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund) does not exceed the specified percentage annually: 0.45% for Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund; 0.80% for High Yield Municipal Fund; 0.85% for Corporate Income Fund, Intermediate Bond Fund, Strategic Income Fund and U.S. Treasury Index Fund. These arrangements may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

d

Class R shares pay a distribution fee pursuant to a Fund’s distribution (Rule 12b-1) plan for Class R shares. The Funds do not have a shareholder service plan for Class R shares.

e

The shareholder service fees for Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a Plan Administration Services Agreement, the Funds’ Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

f

The shareholder servicing fees for Class T shares are up to 0.50% of average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for equity Funds and 0.40% for fixed income Funds. The Funds currently limit such fees to a maximum of 0.30% for equity Funds and 0.15% for fixed income Funds. See Class T Shares Shareholder Service Fees below for more information.

The shareholder servicing plan permits the Funds to compensate or reimburse servicing agents for the shareholder services they have provided. The Distribution Plan, adopted pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, permits the Funds to compensate or reimburse the Distributor and/or selling agents for activities or expenses primarily intended to result in the sale of the classes’ shares. Payments are made at an annual rate and paid monthly, as a percentage of average daily net assets, set from time to time by the Board, and are charged as expenses of each Fund directly to the applicable share class. A substantial portion of the expenses incurred pursuant to these plans may be paid to affiliates of the Distributor and Ameriprise Financial.

Under the shareholder servicing plan, the Board must review, at least quarterly, a written report of the amounts paid under the servicing agreements and the purposes for which those expenditures were made. The initial term of the shareholder servicing plan is one year and it will continue in effect from year to year after its initial one-year term provided that its continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a majority of the Board, including a majority of the Independent Trustees who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the shareholder servicing plan or in any agreement related to it. Any material amendment to the shareholder servicing plan must be approved in the same manner. The shareholder servicing plan is terminable at any time with respect to the Funds by a vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees.

The Trustees believe the Distribution Plan could be a significant factor in the growth and retention of a Fund’s assets resulting in more advantageous expense ratios and increased investment flexibility which could benefit each class of Fund shareholders. The Distribution Plan will continue in effect from year to year so long as continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a vote of the Trustees, including the Independent Trustees. The Distribution Plan may not be amended to increase the fee materially without approval by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares, and all material amendments of the Distribution Plan must be approved by the Trustees in the manner provided in the foregoing sentence. The Distribution Plan may be terminated at any time by vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares.

Class T Shares Shareholder Service Fees

The Funds that offer Class T shares have adopted a shareholder servicing plan that permits them to pay for certain services provided to Class T shareholders by their selling and/or servicing agents. Equity Funds may pay

 

94


Table of Contents

shareholder service fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.50% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.25% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.30% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services. Fixed income Funds may pay shareholder service fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.40% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of an annual rate of up to 0.20% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.20% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.15% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services. The Funds consider “administrative support services” to include, without limitation, (i) aggregating and processing purchase and redemption orders, (ii) providing beneficial owners with statements showing their positions in the Fund, (iii) processing dividend payments, (iv) providing sub-accounting services for Fund shares held beneficially, (v) forwarding shareholder communications, such as proxies, shareholder reports, dividend and tax notices, and updating prospectuses to beneficial owners, (vi) receiving, tabulating and transmitting proxies executed by the beneficial owners, (vii) sub-transfer agent services for beneficial owners of the Fund shares and (viii) other similar services.

Distribution and Service Fees Paid by the Funds

The Distributor and the Previous Distributor received distribution and service fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show distribution and service fees paid to and waived by, as applicable, the Distributor and the Previous Distributor, for the most recently completed fiscal year, except as otherwise indicated. The Trust is not aware as to what amount, if any, of the distribution and service fees paid to the Distributor and Previous Distributor were, on a Fund-by-Fund basis, used for advertising, printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than current shareholders, compensation to broker-dealers, compensation to sales personnel, or interest, carrying or other financing charges. Class Y shares and Class Z shares do not pay distribution and service fees.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2010*

 

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Bond Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           —         $ 13,110         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 29,341         —         $ 4,370         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Corporate Income Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 56,609       $ 84,028         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 204,427       $ 18,855       $ 28,014         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —         $ 16,837         N/A   

Emerging Markets Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 7,090         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 10,730         N/A       $ 2,363         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           N/A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 89,532         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 95,419         N/A       $ 29,844         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           N/A   

Intermediate Bond Fund

           

Distribution Fee

   $ 159,958       $ 266,146       $ 239,468       $ 8,902   

Service Fee

   $ 399,760       $ 88,709       $ 79,839         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

   $ 159,958         —         $ 47,893         N/A   

 

95


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Pacific/Asia Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 2,781         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 1,579         N/A       $ 927         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           N/A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 14,917       $ 618   

Service Fee

   $ 769,303         N/A       $ 4,972         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 56,393       $ 184,245         —     

Service Fee

   $ 148,960       $ 18,798       $ 61,427         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —         $ 36,843         —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 473,717       $ 258,974   

Service Fee

   $ 610,589         N/A       $ 157,906         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid or waived by the Previous Distributor.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended May 31, 2010

 

    Class A Shares     Class B Shares     Class C Shares     Class J Shares*  

Fund

  Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

               

Distribution Fee

    —          —        $ 10,429      $ 147,519      $ 8,223      $ 89,599        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

  $ 41,009      $ 429,929      $ 3,469      $ 49,173      $ 2,714      $ 29,852        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

    —          —          —          —        $ 1,645      $ 17,946        N/A        N/A   

International Bond Fund

               

Distribution Fee

    —          —          N/A        N/A      $ 64      $ 317        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

  $ 213      $ 1,522        N/A        N/A      $ 195      $ 949        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

    —          —          N/A        N/A        —          —          N/A        N/A   

Strategic Income Fund

               

Distribution Fee

    —          —        $ 59,732      $ 774,956      $ 126,549      $ 1,320,458        —        $ 28,560   

Service Fee

  $ 216,952      $ 2,300,745      $ 19,540      $ 255,683      $ 42,458      $ 435,805        —        $ 20,076   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

    —          —          —          —        $ 25,310      $ 262,023        —          —     

 

* On July 27, 2009, Strategic Income Fund liquidated and terminated Class J shares.

 

96


Table of Contents

 

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended June 30, 2010

 

     Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares  

Fund

   Distributor      Previous
Distributor
     Distributor      Previous
Distributor
     Distributor      Previous
Distributor
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

                 

Distribution Fee

     —           —           $7,716         $46,609         $9,271         $44,660   

Service Fee

     $27,169         $112,152         $2,058         $12,428         $3,090         $14,887   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

                 

Distribution Fee

     —           —           $32,481         $188,879         $68,350         $327,919   

Service Fee

     $266,253         $1,175,984         $10,827         $  62,959         $22,783         $109,306   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended August 31, 2010*1

 

     Class A Shares     Class B Shares     Class C Shares     Class R Shares     Class T Shares**  

Fund

  Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
 

Balanced Fund

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $17,743        $36,746        $60,965        $80,541        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

    $48,934        $48,551        $ 5,914        $12,249        $20,477        $26,809        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

                                              N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $15,838        $40,577        $26,090        $50,883        $8,167        $13,987                 

Service Fee

    $55,624        $101,648        $ 5,279        $13,526        $ 8,697        $16,961                               

Fees Waived by the Distributor

        

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

Small Cap Growth Fund I

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $6,386        $14,230        $35,553        $61,671        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

    $54,406        $102,137        $2,129        $ 4,743        $11,851        $20,557        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

        

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

Strategic Investor Fund

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $55,413        $127,463        $43,771        $99,781        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

    $127,413        $277,644        $18,471        $ 42,488        $14,590        $33,260        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

        

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

*

All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

** Paid pursuant to the Shareholder Services Plan for Class T shares.
1

Unaudited.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2009*

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
     Class E
Shares
     Class F
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class T
Shares**
 

Contrarian Core Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 20,833       $ 23,402         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

   $ 35,066       $ 6,953       $ 7,797         N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 299,111   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Dividend Income Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 192,252       $ 194,696         N/A         N/A       $ 689         —     

Service Fee

   $ 810,948       $ 64,084       $ 64,929         N/A         N/A         —         $ 179,754   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A         —           —     

 

97


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
     Class E
Shares
     Class F
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class T
Shares**
 

Large Cap Growth Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 227,129       $ 118,242       $ 11,426       $ 1,852         N/A         —     

Service Fee

   $ 308,522       $ 75,710       $ 39,444       $ 28,565       $ 617         N/A       $ 380,511   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           —           N/A         —     

Small Cap Core Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 113,507       $ 116,645         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

   $ 183,736       $ 37,882       $ 38,938         N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 191,678   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.
** Paid pursuant to the Shareholder Services Plan for Class T shares.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Fund for the Fiscal Year Ended October 31, 2009*

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 68,025       $ 89,850   

Service Fee

   $ 171,733       $ 21,786       $ 28,797   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —         $ 35,944   

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Fund for the Fiscal Year Ended August 31, 2009*

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

        

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 26,912       $ 26,164   

Service Fee

   $ 35,816       $ 8,971       $ 8,721   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Fund for the Fiscal Period Ended December 31, 2009*, 1

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

        

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 8,375       $ 9,509   

Service Fee

   $ 14,539       $ 2,791       $ 3,170   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —     

 

*

All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

1

Data for the fiscal period September 1, 2009 through December 31, 2009.

The Distributor may use the entire amount of its fees to defray the costs of commissions and service fees paid to selling and/or servicing agents and for certain other purposes. Since the distribution and service fees are payable regardless of the Distributor’s expenses, the Distributor may realize a profit from the fees. The Distribution Plan authorizes any other payments by the Funds to the Distributor and its affiliates (including the Adviser) to the extent that such payments might be construed to be indirectly financing the distribution of a Fund’s shares.

 

98


Table of Contents

 

The Funds participate in joint distribution activities with other Columbia Funds. The fees paid under the Distribution Plan adopted by a Fund may be used to finance the distribution of the shares of other Columbia Funds. Such distribution costs are allocated based on the relative net asset size of the respective Funds.

 

99


Table of Contents

 

Codes of Ethics

The Funds, the Adviser and the Distributor have adopted Codes of Ethics pursuant to the requirements of the 1940 Act, including Rule 17j–1 under the 1940 Act. These Codes of Ethics permit personnel subject to the Codes of Ethics to invest in securities, including securities that may be bought or held by the Funds. These Codes of Ethics are included as exhibits to Part C of the Funds’ registration statement. These Codes of Ethics can be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room and may be obtained by calling the SEC at 202.551.8090; they also are available on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, and may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request to publicinfo@sec.gov or by writing to the SEC’s Public Reference Section, Washington, D.C. 20549–1520.

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

The Funds have delegated to the Adviser, or as applicable, the subadviser, the responsibility to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Funds. In deciding to delegate this responsibility to the Adviser, the Board reviewed and approved the policies and procedures adopted by the Adviser and, as applicable, a subadviser. These included the procedures that the Adviser follows when a vote presents a conflict between the interests of the Funds and their shareholders and the Adviser (or subadviser), its affiliates, its other clients or other persons.

The Adviser’s policy is to vote all proxies for Fund securities in a manner considered by the Adviser to be in the best interest of the Funds and their shareholders without regard to any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser examines each proposal and votes against the proposal, if, in its judgment, approval or adoption of the proposal would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities. The Adviser also examines each proposal and votes the proxies against the proposal, if, in its judgment, the proposal would be expected to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. The Adviser determines the best interest of the Funds in light of the potential economic return on each Fund’s investment.

The Adviser seeks to address potential material conflicts of interest by having predetermined voting guidelines. For those proposals that require special consideration or in instances where special circumstances may require varying from the predetermined guideline, the Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee determines the vote in the best interest of the Funds, without consideration of any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee is composed of representatives of the Adviser’s equity investments, equity research, compliance, legal and operations functions. In addition to the responsibilities described above, the Proxy Voting Committee has the responsibility to review, at least annually, the Adviser’s proxy voting policies to ensure consistency with internal policies and regulatory requirements and to develop additional predetermined voting guidelines to assist in the review of proxy proposals.

The Proxy Voting Committee may vary from a predetermined guideline if it determines that voting on the proposal according to the predetermined guideline would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities or to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. References to the best interests of the Funds refer to the interest of the Funds in terms of the potential economic return on the client’s investment. In determining the vote on any proposal, the Proxy Voting Committee does not consider any benefit other than benefits to the Funds. A member of the Proxy Voting Committee is prohibited from voting on any proposal for which he or she has a conflict of interest by reason of a direct relationship with the issuer or other party affected by a given proposal. Persons making recommendations to the Proxy Voting Committee or its members are required to disclose to the Committee any relationship with a party making a proposal or other matter known to the person that would create a potential conflict of interest.

The Adviser has retained Glass-Lewis & Co., a third-party vendor, to implement its proxy voting process. Glass-Lewis & Co. provides proxy analysis, record keeping services and vote disclosure services.

Information regarding how the Columbia Funds (except certain Columbia Funds that do not invest in voting securities) voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent twelve month period ended June 30 will be available by August 31 of this year free of charge: (i) through the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com and (ii) on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. For a copy of the Adviser’s (and subadviser’s) policies and procedures that are used to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Columbia Funds, see Appendix B to this SAI.

 

100


Table of Contents

 

FUND GOVERNANCE

The Board

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

The Board oversees the Trust and the Funds. The Trustees are responsible for overseeing the management and operations of the Trust. The Board consists of ten Trustees who have varied experience and skills. Nine of the Trustees, including the Chairman of the Board, are Independent Trustees. The remaining Trustee, Mr. William E. Mayer, may technically be an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Columbia Funds by reason of his affiliation with WR Hambrecht + Co., a registered broker/dealer that may execute portfolio transactions for, engage in principal transactions with, or distribute shares of a Fund or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or any subadviser to a Fund. Further information about the backgrounds and qualifications of the Trustees can be found in the section Trustee Biographical Information and Qualifications. The Board has several standing committees, which are an integral part of each Fund’s overall governance and risk oversight structure. The committees include the Audit Committee, the Governance Committee, the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee, the Compliance Committee and the Investment Oversight Committees. A majority of the members of each of the committees are Independent Trustees. The roles of each committee are more fully described in the section Standing Committees below.

The Funds have retained the Adviser as the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator. The Adviser provides the Funds with investment advisory services, and is responsible for day-to-day administration of the Funds and management of the risks that arise from the Funds’ investments and operations. The Board provides oversight of the services provided by the Adviser, including risk management services. In addition, each committee of the Board provides oversight of the Adviser’s risk management services with respect to the particular activities within the committee’s purview. In the course of providing oversight, the Board and the committees receive a wide range of reports with respect to the Funds’ activities, including reports regarding each Fund’s investment portfolio, the compliance of the Funds with applicable laws, and the Funds’ financial accounting and reporting. The Board and the relevant committees meet periodically with officers of the Funds and the Adviser, with independent consultants hired by the Board, and with representatives of various of the Funds’ service providers. The Board and certain committees also meet periodically with the Funds’ chief compliance officer, who also serves as chief compliance officer of the Adviser, to receive reports regarding the compliance of the Funds and the Adviser with the federal securities laws and their internal compliance policies and procedures. In addition, the Board meets periodically with the portfolio managers of the Funds to receive reports regarding the management of the Funds, including their investment risks.

The Board reviews its leadership structure periodically and believes that its structure is appropriate, in light of the size of the Trust and the nature of its business, to enable the Board to exercise its oversight of the Funds and the other investment companies overseen by the Trustees. In particular, the Board believes that having an Independent Trustee serve as the chair of the Board and having other Independent Trustees serve as chairs of each committee promotes independence from the Adviser in setting agendas and conducting meetings. The Board believes that its committee structure makes the oversight process more efficient and more effective by allowing, among other things, smaller groups of Trustees to bring increased focus to matters within the purview of each committee.

Standing Committees

Ms. Verville and Messrs. Collins, Hacker and Nelson are members of the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee’s functions include making recommendations to the Board regarding the selection and performance of the independent registered public accounting firm, and reviewing matters relating to accounting and auditing practices and procedures, accounting records and the internal accounting controls of the Funds and certain service providers.

 

101


Table of Contents

 

Messrs. Drake, Hacker, Mayer and Simpson are members of the Governance Committee. The Governance Committee’s functions include recommending to the Board nominees for Independent Trustee positions and for appointments to various committees, overseeing the Board’s periodic evaluations of the effectiveness of the Board, reviewing and recommending to the Board governance and other policies and practices to be followed in carrying out the Trustees’ duties and responsibilities and reviewing and making recommendations to the Board regarding the compensation of the Trustees who are not affiliated with the Adviser.

The Governance Committee will consider nominees for Trustee recommended by shareholders provided that such recommendations are submitted by the date disclosed in a Fund’s proxy statement and otherwise comply with applicable securities laws, including Rule 14a-8 under the 1934 Act. Such shareholder recommendations must be in writing and should be sent to the attention of the Governance Committee in care of the Fund at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111-2621. Shareholder recommendations should include the proposed nominee’s biographical information (including business experience for the past ten years) and a description of the qualifications of the proposed nominee, along with a statement from the proposed nominee that he or she is willing to serve and meets the requirements to be a disinterested Trustee, if applicable.

Ms. Kelly and Messrs. Hacker, Mayer, Nelson, Neuhauser and Piel are members of the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee. The Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee’s functions include reviewing and making recommendations to the Board as to contracts requiring approval of a majority of the Independent Trustees and as to any other contracts that may be referred to the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee by the Board.

Mses. Kelly and Verville and Messrs. Nelson and Simpson are members of the Compliance Committee. The Compliance Committee’s functions include, among other things, monitoring, supervising and assessing the performance of each Fund’s Chief Compliance Officer and reviewing her compensation, reviewing periodically and recommending changes to the codes of ethics and compliance policies of each Fund and its service providers, and reviewing each Fund’s portfolio execution.

Each Trustee also serves on an Investment Oversight Committee (IOC). Each IOC is responsible for monitoring, on an ongoing basis, a select group of funds in the Columbia Funds Family and gives particular consideration to such matters as each Fund’s adherence to its investment mandates, historical performance, changes in investment processes and personnel, and proposed changes to investment objectives. Investment personnel who manage the Funds attend IOC meetings from time to time to assist each IOC in its review of the Funds. Each IOC meets four times a year, as the applicable IOC did for each Fund’s most recently completed fiscal year. The below are members of the respective IOCs and the general categories of funds in the Columbia Funds Family which they review. These asset categories may be reassigned among the IOCs from time to time.

IOC #1: Mr. Neuhauser and Ms. Verville are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Global Stock, International Stock, Large Growth, Mid Value; Fixed Income – Core and Municipal.

IOC #2: Messrs. Collins, Hacker and Mayer are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Large Value, Small Growth, Specialty; Fixed Income – High Yield, Multi-Sector and Municipal.

IOC #3: Mr. Piel and Ms. Kelly are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Asset Allocation, Index, Large Value, Mid Value, Small Core, Small Value, Money Market; Fixed Income – Municipal and Short Duration.

IOC #4: Messrs. Drake, Nelson and Simpson are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Asset Allocation, Large Blend, Mid Growth, Multi Blend, Small Growth, Specialty; Fixed Income – Core, Municipal and Short Duration.

 

102


Table of Contents

 

The table below shows the number of times each committee met during each Fund’s most recent fiscal year. The table is organized by fiscal year end.

 

Fiscal Period

   Audit
Committee
    Governance
Committee
    Advisory Fees &
Expenses
Committee
    Compliance
Committee
    Investment
Oversight

Committee
 

For Funds with fiscal periods ending March 31

     8        6        8        8        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending May 31

     8        7        8        9        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending June 30

     8        7        8        8        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending August 31

     8        7        9        7        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending September 30

     6        6        8        7        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending October 31

     6        6        8        7        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending December 31

     3 a      2 a      4 a      4 a      1 a 

 

a

In 2009, Real Estate Equity Fund changed its fiscal year end from August 31 to December 31. The number of committee meetings in the table above reflects the period from September 1, 2009 through December 31, 2009. For the fiscal year ended August 31, 2009, the Audit Committee met six times, the Governance Committee met six times, the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee met eight times, the Compliance Committee met six times and each IOC met four times.

Trustee Biographical Information and Qualifications

The following provides an overview of the considerations that led the Board to conclude that each individual serving as a Trustee should so serve. Generally, no one factor was decisive in the selection of an individual to join the Board. Among the factors the Board considered when concluding that an individual should serve on the Board were the following: (i) the individual’s business and professional experience and accomplishments; (ii) the individual’s ability to work effectively with the other Trustees; (iii) the individual’s prior experience, if any, serving on the boards of public companies (including, where relevant, other investment companies) and other complex enterprises and organizations; and (iv) how the individual’s skills, experience and attributes would contribute to an appropriate mix of relevant skills and experience on the Board.

In respect of each current Trustee, the individual’s substantial professional accomplishments and experience, including in fields related to the operations of the Fund, were a significant factor in the determination that, in light of the business and structure of the Trust, the individual should serve as a Trustee. Following is a summary of each Trustee’s particular professional experience and additional considerations that contributed to the Board’s conclusion that an individual should serve as a Trustee:

Rodman L. Drake – Mr. Drake has significant experience serving as a CEO on boards of directors for public companies, including investment companies. This experience includes holding such positions with the various boards as chairman, lead independent director, and chairman of the nominating, compensation and audit committees. Mr. Drake is Co-Founder of Baringo Capital LLC, and was previously the CEO of a hybrid REIT, president of a private equity firm and the CEO of a leading management consulting firm.

John D. Collins – Mr. Collins was a partner at KPMG, LLP, where he worked for 37 years until his retirement in 1999. Mr. Collins has served on the board of directors for multiple companies. While with KPMG LLP, Mr. Collins was a senior audit partner. He also served on the International Auditing Procedures Committee.

 

103


Table of Contents

 

Douglas A. Hacker – Mr. Hacker has extensive executive experience, having served in various executive roles with United Airlines and more recently as an independent business executive. Mr. Hacker also has experience on other boards of directors. As former chief financial officer of United Airlines, Mr. Hacker has significant experience in accounting and financial management, including in a public company setting.

Janet Langford Kelly – Ms. Kelly is Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary for ConocoPhillips. Prior to joining ConocoPhillips Ms. Kelly held senior legal and leadership roles in other large corporations and law firms, including as a partner at the law firms Sidley & Austin and at Zelle, Hoffman, Voelbel, Mason and Gette. Ms. Kelly has previously served on the board of directors for a public company and various industry groups and non-profit organizations.

Charles R. Nelson – Dr. Nelson is an experienced investment company trustee, having served on the Board, and the boards of predecessor funds, since 1981. Professor of Economics at the University of Washington since 1976, he has written several books, authored numerous articles in economics and finance, and served on editorial boards of professional journals. He is a Fellow of the Econometric Society and his contributions were the subject of a conference at the Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta in 2006. Additionally, he is an experienced consultant on economic and statistical matters.

John J. Neuhauser – Dr. Neuhauser is an experienced investment company trustee, having served on the Board since 1985 and on the boards of other investment companies. In addition to his board experience, Dr. Neuhauser has extensive executive experience. He is currently the President of Saint Michael’s College and has served in a variety of other leadership roles in higher education.

Jonathan Piel – Mr. Piel has served since 1994 as a trustee of mutual funds advised successively by U.S. Trust, Charles Schwab and the Adviser. In addition to this significant oversight experience he was the Editor of Scientific American and a vice president of Scientific American, Inc. He is also a member of the board of several not-for-profit organizations.

Patrick J. Simpson – Mr. Simpson is a partner at the law firm Perkins Coie L.L.P. Mr. Simpson’s practice includes such relevant areas as corporate governance and securities compliance.

Anne-Lee Verville – Ms. Verville has significant executive experience. Prior to her retirement in 1997, she held various leadership and executive roles with IBM Corporation. Ms. Verville has previously served on the board of directors for a public company and non-profit organizations.

William E. Mayer – Mr. Mayer has significant executive and board experience with financial services and investment companies. Mr. Mayer, currently a partner at a private equity firm, also has significant executive experience and experience working in finance. Previously, Mr. Mayer was a professor and Dean of the College of Business and Management at the University of Maryland and was President and CEO of The First Boston Corporation.

 

104


Table of Contents

 

The following table provides additional biographical information about the Trustees as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period. The mailing address of each Trustee is: c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, One Financial Center, Mail Stop MA5-515-11-05, Boston, MA 02111.

Independent Trustee Biographical Information

 

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

Rodman L. Drake
(Born 1943)
Trustee and Chairman of the Board
     1994       Independent consultant since 2010; Co-Founder of Baringo Capital LLC (private equity) from 1997 to 2008; CEO of Crystal River Capital, Inc. (real estate investment trust) from 2003 to 2010      64       Jackson Hewitt Tax Service Inc. (tax preparation services); Student Loan Corporation (student loan provider); Celgene Corporation (global biotechnology company); Crystal River Capital, Inc. from 2005 to 2010; Parsons Brinckerhoff from 1995-2008; and The Helios Funds (exchange-traded funds); Apex Silver Mines Ltd. from 2007 to 2009
John D. Collins
(Born 1938)
Trustee
     2005       Retired. Consultant, KPMG, LLP (accounting and tax firm) from July 1999 to June 2000; Partner, KPMG, LLP (accounting and tax firm) from March 1962 to June 1999      64       Mrs. Fields Original Cookies, Inc. (consumer products); Suburban Propane Partners, L.P.; and Montpelier Re (insurance underwriting firm)
Douglas A. Hacker
(Born 1955)
Trustee
     1996       Independent business executive since May 2006; Executive Vice President – Strategy of United Airlines from December 2002 to May 2006; President of UAL Loyalty Services (airline marketing company) from September 2001 to December 2002; Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of United Airlines from July 1999 to September 2001      64       Nash Finch Company (food distributor) and Aircastle Limited (aircraft leasing)

 

105


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

Janet Langford Kelly
(Born 1957)
Trustee
     1996       Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary, ConocoPhillips (integrated energy company) since September 2007; Deputy General Counsel – Corporate Legal Services, ConocoPhillips from August 2006 to August 2007; Partner, Zelle, Hofmann, Voelbel, Mason & Gette LLP (law firm) from March 2005 to July 2006; Adjunct Professor of Law, Northwestern University from September 2004 to June 2006; Director, UAL Corporation (airline) from February 2006 to July 2006; Chief Administrative Officer and Senior Vice President, Kmart Holding Corporation (consumer goods) from September 2003 to March 2004      64       None
Charles R. Nelson
(Born 1942)
Trustee
     1981       Professor of Economics, University of Washington since January 1976; Ford and Louisa Van Voorhis Professor of Political Economy, University of Washington since September 1993; Adjunct Professor of Statistics, University of Washington since September 1980; Associate Editor, Journal of Money, Credit and Banking from September 1993 to 2008; consultant on econometric and statistical matters      64       None

 

106


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

John J. Neuhauser
(Born 1943)
Trustee
     1984       President, Saint Michael’s College, since August 2007; University Professor, Boston College from November 2005 to August 2007; Director or Trustee of several non-profit organizations, including Fletcher Allen Health Care, Inc.; Academic Vice President and Dean of Faculties, Boston College from August 1999 to October 2005      64       Liberty All-Star Equity Fund and Liberty All-Star Growth Fund, Inc. (closed-end funds)
Jonathan Piel
(Born 1938)
Trustee
     1994       Cable television producer and web site designer; The Editor, Scientific American from 1984 to 1994; Vice President, Scientific American, Inc. from 1984 to 1994; Member, Advisory Board, Stone Age Institute, Bloomington, Indiana (research institute that explores the effect of technology on human evolution); Member, Board of Directors of the National Institute of Social Sciences, New York City; Member, Board of Trustees of the William Alanson White Institute, New York City (institution for training psychoanalysts); Member, Advisory Board, Mount Sinai Children’s Environmental Health Center, New York      64       None
Patrick J. Simpson
(Born 1944)
Trustee
     2000       Partner, Perkins Coie L.L.P. (law firm)      64       None

 

107


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

Anne-Lee Verville
(Born 1945)
Trustee
     1998       Retired since 1997 (formerly, General Manager, Global Education Industry from 1994 to 1997; President – Application Systems Division from 1991 to 1994; Chief Financial Officer – US Marketing & Services from 1988 to 1991; and Chief Information Officer from 1987 to 1988, IBM Corporation (computer and technology))      64       Enesco Group, Inc. (producer of giftware and home and garden decor products) from 2001 to 2006

Interested Trustee Biographical Information

 

Name, Year of
Birth and Position
Held with the Trust

   Year First
Appointed or
Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia
Funds Complex
or a Predecessor
Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During
the Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in
the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships

Held by Trustee During the
Past Five Years

William E. Mayer *
(Born 1940)
Trustee
     1994       Partner, Park Avenue Equity Partners (private equity) since February 1999; Dean and Professor, College of Business and Management University of Maryland from 1992 to 1996      64       DynaVox Inc. (software developer); Lee Enterprises (print media); WR Hambrecht + Co. (financial service provider); and BlackRock Kelso Capital Corporation (investment company)

 

* Mr. Mayer may technically be an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Columbia Funds by reason of his affiliation with WR Hambrecht + Co., a registered broker/dealer that may execute portfolio transactions for, engage in principal transactions with, or distribute shares of a Fund or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or any subadviser to a Fund.

 

108


Table of Contents

 

Compensation

Trustees are compensated for their services to the Columbia Funds complex on a complex-wide basis, as shown in the table below.

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund
Independent Trustees
 

Fund

  Rodman  L.
Drake(1)
    John D.
Collins(2)
    Douglas A.
Hacker
    Janet
Langford
Kelly
    Charles R.
Nelson
    John J.
Neuhauser
    Jonathan
Piel
    Patrick J.
Simpson(3)
    Thomas C.
Theobald(4)
    Anne-Lee
Verville(5)
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

  

Bond Fund

  $ 4,544      $ 3,582      $ 3,867      $ 3,600      $ 3,820      $ 3,533      $ 3,305      $ 3,599      $ 3,154      $ 3,739   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,526      $ 1,590      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,599      $ 0      $ 0   

Corporate Income Fund

  $ 4,205      $ 3,321      $ 3,586      $ 3,337      $ 3,547      $ 3,276      $ 3,065      $ 3,337      $ 2,923      $ 3,469   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,416      $ 1,480      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,337      $ 0      $ 0   

Emerging Markets Fund

  $ 3,100      $ 2,472      $ 2,678      $ 3,099      $ 1,969      $ 2,446      $ 2,292      $ 2,355      $ 2,172      $ 2,601   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,060      $ 2,188      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,355      $ 0      $ 0   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

  $ 3,888      $ 3,086      $ 3,341      $ 1,920      $ 2,671      $ 3,060      $ 2,868      $ 2,977      $ 2,691      $ 3,250   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,575      $ 2,738      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,977      $ 0      $ 0   

Intermediate Bond Fund

  $ 13,357      $ 10,532      $ 11,358      $ 10,581      $ 11,198      $ 10,374      $ 9,698      $ 10,555      $ 9,353      $ 10,967   

Amount deferred

  $ 4,491      $ 4,604      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 10,555      $ 0      $ 0   

Pacific/Asia Fund

  $ 1,588      $ 1,260      $ 1,363      $ 1,267      $ 1,353      $ 1,244      $ 1,165      $ 1,306      $ 1,104      $ 1,320   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,060      $ 1,118      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,306      $ 0      $ 0   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  $ 7,034      $ 5,587      $ 6,059      $ 5,625      $ 6,079      $ 5,569      $ 5,226      $ 4,880      $ 4,870      $ 5,919   

Amount deferred

  $ 4,591      $ 4,937      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,880      $ 0      $ 0   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

  $ 3,628      $ 2,846      $ 3,067      $ 2,854      $ 3,008      $ 2,789      $ 2,606      $ 2,836      $ 2,471      $ 2,947   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,204      $ 1,262      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,836      $ 0      $ 0   

Value and Restructuring Fund

  $ 33,775      $ 26,803      $ 28,951      $ 26,950      $ 28,828      $ 26,576      $ 24,874      $ 22,548      $ 23,966      $ 28,137   

Amount deferred

  $ 11,452      $ 11,817      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 22,548      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending May 31

  

High Yield Opportunity Fund

  $ 3,616      $ 2,742      $ 2,978      $ 2,763      $ 2,945      $ 2,686      $ 2,524      $ 2,760      $ 1,652      $ 2,845   

Amount deferred

  $ 920      $ 1,437      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,760      $ 0      $ 0   

International Bond Fund

  $ 1,694      $ 1,286      $ 1,399      $ 1,297      $ 1,088      $ 1,038      $ 962      $ 1,037      $ 541      $ 1,076   

Amount deferred

  $ 429      $ 676      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,037      $ 0      $ 0   

Strategic Income Fund

  $ 13,920      $ 10,524      $ 11,407      $ 10,585      $ 11,283      $ 10,309      $ 9,680      $ 10,576      $ 6,427      $ 10,914   

Amount deferred

  $ 3,532      $ 5,457      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 10,576      $ 0      $ 0   

 

109


Table of Contents
    Aggregate Compensation from Fund
Independent Trustees
 

Fund

  Rodman  L.
Drake(1)
    John D.
Collins(2)
    Douglas A.
Hacker
    Janet
Langford
Kelly
    Charles R.
Nelson
    John J.
Neuhauser
    Jonathan
Piel
    Patrick J.
Simpson(3)
    Thomas C.
Theobald(4)
    Anne-Lee
Verville(5)
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending June 30

  

High Yield Municipal Fund

  $ 4,982      $ 3,854      $ 4,247      $ 3,862      $ 4,118      $ 3,778      $ 3,555      $ 3,834      $ 2,098      $ 3,967   

Amount deferred.

  $ 1,903      $ 2,066      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,834      $ 0      $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund I

  $ 7,259      $ 5,618      $ 6,198      $ 5,619      $ 6,047      $ 5,539      $ 5,214      $ 5,618      $ 2,833      $ 5,818   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,497      $ 3,019      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 5,618      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending August 31

  

Balanced Fund

  $ 3,975      $ 2,999      $ 3,314      $ 2,993      $ 2,802      $ 2,560      $ 2,403      $ 2,557      $ 1,014      $ 3,524   

Amount deferred

  $ 370      $ 1,464      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,557      $ 0      $ 0   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

  $ 7,404      $ 5,624      $ 6,239      $ 5,647      $ 6,036      $ 5,541      $ 5,190      $ 5,520      $ 1,875      $ 5,787   

Amount deferred

  $ 982      $ 2,814      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 5,520      $ 0      $ 0   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

  $ 4,817      $ 3,671      $ 4,077      $ 3,679      $ 3,937      $ 3,617      $ 3,391      $ 3,598      $ 1,117      $ 3,768   

Amount deferred

  $ 602      $ 1,862      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,598      $ 0      $ 0   

Strategic Investor Fund

  $ 5,856      $ 4,446      $ 4,931      $ 4,467      $ 4,774      $ 4,381      $ 4,103      $ 4,366      $ 1,518      $ 4,578   

Amount deferred

  $ 791      $ 2,220      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,366      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending September 30

  

Contrarian Core Fund

  $ 2,386      $ 2,052      $ 2,262      $ 2,208      $ 2,360      $ 2,177      $ 2,046      $ 2,209      $ 2,702      $ 2,287   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,431      $ 1,170      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,209      $ 493      $ 0   

Dividend Income Fund

  $ 5,256      $ 4,430      $ 4,869      $ 4,728      $ 5,092      $ 4,719      $ 4,423      $ 4,782      $ 5,728      $ 4,953   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,192      $ 2,131      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,782      $ 0      $ 0   

Large Cap Growth Fund

  $ 6,532      $ 5,645      $ 6,229      $ 6,083      $ 6,490      $ 5,994      $ 5,632      $ 6,069      $ 7,509      $ 6,288   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,868      $ 2,788      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 6,069      $ 0      $ 0   

Small Cap Core Fund

  $ 3,483      $ 3,044      $ 3,368      $ 3,299      $ 3,550      $ 3,262      $ 3,070      $ 3,309      $ 4,132      $ 3,430   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,561      $ 1,519      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,309      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending October 31

  

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

  $ 1,666      $ 1,331      $ 1,452      $ 1,401      $ 1,491      $ 1,388      $ 1,294      $ 1,397      $ 1,546      $ 1,447   

Amount deferred

  $ 663      $ 638      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,397      $ 0      $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal period ended December 31, 2009 and fiscal year ended August 31, 2009, respectively

  

Real Estate Equity Fund

  $ 868      $ 694      $ 792      $ 735      $ 783      $ 695      $ 660      $ 707      $ 508      $ 745   

Amount deferred

  $ 929      $ 903      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,952      $ 0      $ 0   

Real Estate Equity Fund

  $ 2,108      $ 1,822      $ 1,998      $ 1,950      $ 2,086      $ 1,938      $ 1,821      $ 1,952      $ 2,057      $ 2,021   

Amount deferred

  $ 397      $ 412      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 707      $ 0      $ 0   

 

1

During the calendar year December 31, 2009, Mr. Drake deferred $116,500 of his total compensation from the Columbia Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Drake’s account under that plan was $223,507.

 

110


Table of Contents
2

During the calendar year December 31, 2009, Mr. Collins deferred $116,000 of his total compensation from the Columbia Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Collins’ account under that plan was $205,097.

3

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Simpson deferred $236,000 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Simpson’s account under that plan was $1,051,968.

4

At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Theobald’s account under the deferred compensation plan was $600,183. Mr. Theobald served as a Trustee of the Trust until February 2010.

5

At December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Verville’s account under the deferred compensation plan was $679,903.

 

Aggregate Compensation from Fund   
     Interested Trustee  

Fund

   William E. Mayer  

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

  

Bond Fund

   $ 3,532   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Corporate Income Fund

   $ 3,277   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Emerging Markets Fund

   $ 2,453   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   $ 3,069   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Intermediate Bond Fund

   $ 10,361   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Pacific/Asia Fund

   $ 1,247   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 5,602   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

   $ 2,780   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Value and Restructuring Fund

   $ 26,607   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending May 31

  

High Yield Opportunity Fund

   $ 2,716   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

International Bond Fund

   $ 1,016   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Strategic Income Fund

   $ 10,405   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending June 30

  

High Yield Municipal Fund

   $ 3,813   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund I

   $ 5,604   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending August 31

  

Balanced Fund

   $ 3,040   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   $ 5,581   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   $ 3,649   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Strategic Investor Fund

   $ 4,411   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

 

111


Table of Contents
     Interested Trustee  

Fund

   William E. Mayer  

For Funds with fiscal year ending September 30

  

Contrarian Core Fund

   $ 2,121   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Dividend Income Fund

   $ 4,604   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 5,829   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Small Cap Core Fund

   $ 3,171   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending October 31

  

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   $ 1,388   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal year ended August 31, 2009 and fiscal period ended December 31, 2009, respectively

   

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 1,887   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 707   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Independent Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Name of Trustee

   Total Compensation from the Columbia
Funds Complex Paid to  Independent Trustees
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a
 

Rodman L. Drake

   $ 275,955   

John D. Collins

   $ 226,990   

Douglas A. Hacker

   $ 251,005   

Janet Langford Kelly

   $ 234,000   

Charles R. Nelson

   $ 249,500   

John J. Neuhauser

   $ 233,500   

Jonathan Piel

   $ 218,500   

Patrick J. Simpson

   $ 236,000   

Thomas C. Theobaldb

   $ 248,550   

Anne-Lee Verville

   $ 244,000   

 

a

All Trustees receive reimbursements for reasonable expenses related to their attendance at meetings of the Board or standing committees, which are not included in the amounts shown.

b

Mr. Theobald served as a Trustee of the Trust until February 2010.

Interested Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Name of Trustee

   Total Compensation from the Columbia
Funds Complex Paid to Interested Trustee
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a
 

William E. Mayer

   $ 233,500   

 

a

Mr. Mayer receives reimbursements for reasonable expenses related to his attendance at meetings of the Board or standing committees, which are not included in the amounts shown.

 

112


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Funds Deferred Compensation Plan

Under the terms of the Deferred Fee Agreement (the Deferred Compensation Plan), each eligible Trustee may elect, on an annual basis, to defer receipt of all or a portion of compensation payable to him or her for service as Trustee for that calendar year (expressly, a Trustee may elect to defer his/her annual retainer, his/her attendance fees, or both components, which together comprise total compensation for service). Fees deferred by a Trustee are credited to a book reserve account (the Deferral Account) established by the Columbia Funds, the value of which is derived from the rate of return of one or more Columbia Funds selected by the Trustee (with accruals to the Deferral Account beginning at such time as a Trustee’s fund elections having been established, and proceeds for service having been paid into such account, and terminating at such time as when proceeds become payable to such Trustee under the Deferred Compensation Plan). Trustees may change their fund elections only in accordance with the provisions of the Deferred Compensation Plan.

Distributions from a Trustee’s Deferral Account will be paid by check, either in a lump sum or in annual installments. Payments made in annual installments are disbursed over a period of up to ten years, following such time as a Trustee may qualify to receive such payments. If a deferring Trustee dies prior to or after the commencement of the disbursement of amounts accrued in his/her Deferral Account, the balance of the account will be distributed to his/her designated beneficiary either in lump sum or in annual payments as established by such Trustee himself/herself, his/her beneficiary or his/her estate. Amounts payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan are not funded or secured in any way, and each deferring Trustee has the status of an unsecured creditor of the Columbia Fund(s) from which compensation has been deferred.

Beneficial Equity Ownership

As of the date of this SAI, the Trustees and Officers of the Trust, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of each class of shares of each Fund. The table below shows, for each Trustee, the amount of Fund equity securities beneficially owned by the Trustee and the aggregate value of all investments in equity securities of the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustee, stated as one of the following ranges: A = $0; B = $1-$10,000; C = $10,001-$50,000; D = $50,001-$100,000; and E = over $100,000.

Independent Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   John D.
Collins
     Rodman L.
Drake
    Douglas A.
Hacker
     Janet Langford
Kelly
     Charles R.
Nelson
 

Balanced Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Bond Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Contrarian Core Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Corporate Income Fund

     A         A        A         A         E   

Dividend Income Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Emerging Markets Fund

     C         C 1      E         A         A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

High Yield Municipal Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     A         A        E         A         D   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     A         A        A         A         E   

International Bond Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Large Cap Growth Fund

     A         A        A         A         D   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     A         A        A         E         E   

Pacific/Asia Fund

     C         A        A         A         A   

Real Estate Equity Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     C         D 1      A         A         A   

Small Cap Core Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     A         A        A         A         A   

 

113


Table of Contents

Fund

   John D.
Collins
    Rodman L.
Drake
    Douglas A.
Hacker
     Janet Langford
Kelly
     Charles R.
Nelson
 

Small Cap Value Fund I

     A        A        A         A         A   

Strategic Income Fund

     E        D 1      E         E         E   

Strategic Investor Fund

     A        A        A         C         A   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     A        A        A         A         A   

Value and Restructuring Fund

     C 1      C 1      A         A         A   

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

     E 1      E 1      E         E         E   

 

1

Includes the value of compensation payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan that is determined as if the amounts deferred had been invested, as of the date of deferral, in shares of one or more funds in the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustee as specified by each Trustee.

Independent Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   John J.
Neuhauser
     Jonathan
Piel
     Patrick J
Simpson
    Anne–Lee
Verville
 

Balanced Fund

     A         A         C        A   

Bond Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Contrarian Core Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Corporate Income Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Dividend Income Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Emerging Markets Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     A         A         A        A   

High Yield Municipal Fund

     A         A         A        A   

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     A         A         A        A   

International Bond Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Large Cap Growth Fund

     A         A         D        A   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     A         A         C        A   

Pacific/Asia Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Real Estate Equity Fund

     A         A         C        A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Small Cap Core Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     A         A         A        A   

Small Cap Value Fund I

     D         A         A        A   

Strategic Income Fund

     E         A         E        E 1 

Strategic Investor Fund

     A         A         A        A   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Value and Restructuring Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

     E         A         E 1      E 1 

 

1

Includes the value of compensation payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan that is determined as if the amounts deferred had been invested, as of the date of deferral, in shares of one or more funds in the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustee as specified by each Trustee.

 

114


Table of Contents

 

Interested Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   William E. Mayer  

Balanced Fund

     A   

Bond Fund

     A   

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     A   

Contrarian Core Fund

     A   

Corporate Income Fund

     A   

Dividend Income Fund

     A   

Emerging Markets Fund

     A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     A   

High Yield Municipal Fund

     A   

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     A   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     A   

International Bond Fund

     A   

Large Cap Growth Fund

     A   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     A   

Pacific/Asia Fund

     A   

Real Estate Equity Fund

     A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     A   

Small Cap Core Fund

     A   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     A   

Small Cap Value Fund I

     A   

Strategic Income Fund

     A   

Strategic Investor Fund

     A   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     A   

Value and Restructuring Fund

     A   

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

     A   

 

115


Table of Contents

 

The Officers

The following table provides basic information about the Officers of the Trust as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period. The mailing address of each Officer is: c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, One Financial Center, Mail Stop MA5-515-11-05, Boston, MA 02111.

Officer Biographical Information

 

Name and

Year of Birth

   Position with  the
Trust
   Year First Elected or
Appointed to
Office
    

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

J. Kevin Connaughton

(Born 1964)

   President      2009       Senior Vice President and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President, Columbia Funds, since 2009, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010 (previously Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Columbia Funds, from June 2008 to January 2009, Treasurer, Columbia Funds, from October 2003 to May 2008, and senior officer of various other affiliated funds since 2000); Managing Director, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from December 2004 to April 2010.
Michael G. Clarke
(Born 1969)
   Senior Vice President
and Chief Financial
Officer
     2009       Vice President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Managing Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from September 2004 to April 2010; senior officer of Columbia Funds and affiliated funds since 2002.
Scott R. Plummer
(Born 1959)
   Senior Vice President,
Secretary and Chief
Legal Officer
     2010       Chief Legal Officer and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since June 2005; Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, from 2005 to April 2010, and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance from 2004 to 2005); Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, RiverSource Funds, since December 2006; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since May 2010.

 

116


Table of Contents

Name and

Year of Birth

   Position with  the
Trust
   Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office
    

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

Linda J. Wondrack
(Born 1964)
   Senior Vice President
and Chief Compliance
Officer
     2007       Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Funds, since 2007, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, from June 2005 to April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer of MFS Investment Management (investment management) from August 2004 to May 2005.
William F. Truscott
(Born 1960)
   Senior Vice President      2010       Chairman of the Board, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to April 2010); Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President, Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer from 2005 to April 2010, and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to 2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer from 2008 to April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006.

Colin Moore

(Born 1958)

   Senior Vice President      2010       Director and Chief Investment Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2002 to 2007.

 

117


Table of Contents

Name and

Year of Birth

   Position with  the
Trust
   Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

Michael A. Jones
(Born 1959)
   Senior Vice President    2010    Director and President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from November 2006 to April 2010; previously, co-president and senior managing director at Robeco Investment Management.

Amy Johnson

(Born 1965)

   Senior Vice President    2010    Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010 (previously Chief Administrative Officer, from 2009 until April 2010, Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, from 2006 to 2009, and Vice President – Operations and Compliance from 2004 to 2006).
Joseph F. DiMaria
(Born 1968)
   Treasurer and Chief
Accounting Officer
   Treasurer since
2009 and Chief
Accounting Officer
since 2008
   Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2006 to April 2010; Head of Tax/Compliance and Assistant Treasurer, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from November 2004 to December 2005.
Marybeth Pilat
(Born 1968)
   Deputy Treasurer    2010    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Vice President, Investment Operations, Bank of America, from October 2008 to April 2010; Finance Manager, Boston Children’s Hospital from August 2008 to October 2008; Director, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from May 2007 to July 2008; Vice President, Mutual Fund Valuation, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from January 2006 to May 2007; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2005 to January 2006.

 

118


Table of Contents

Name and

Year of Birth

  

Position with the
Trust

   Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

Julian Quero
(Born 1967)
   Deputy Treasurer    2008    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from August 2008 to April 2010; Senior Tax Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from August 2006 to July 2008; Senior Compliance Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from April 2002 to August 2006.

Kathryn Thompson

(Born 1967)

   Assistant Treasurer    2006    Director, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight and Treasury of the Adviser, since May 2010; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight of the Previous Adviser from December 2004 to April 2010; Vice President, State Street Corporation (financial services) prior to December 2004.

Stephen T. Welsh

(Born 1957)

   Vice President    2006    President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Services, Inc. from July 2004 to April 2010; Managing Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from August 2007 to April 2010.
Paul B. Goucher
(Born 1968)
   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel of Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel from November 2008 to January 2010); Director, Managing Director and General Counsel of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated (Seligman) from July 2008 to November 2008 and Managing Director and Associate General Counsel of Seligman from January 2005 to July 2008.

Christopher O. Petersen

(Born 1970)

   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel or Counsel from April 2004 to January 2010); Assistant Secretary of RiverSource Funds since January 2007.
Ryan C. Larrenaga
(Born 1970)
   Assistant Secretary    2005    Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since May 2010; Assistant General Counsel, Bank of America from March 2005 to April 2010; Associate, Ropes & Gray LLP (law firm) from 1998 to February 2005.

 

119


Table of Contents

 

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

Subject to policies established by the Board, the Adviser (or the investment subadviser(s) who make the day-to-day investment decisions for a Fund, as applicable) is responsible for decisions to buy and sell securities for each Fund, for the selection of broker/dealers, for the execution of a Fund’s securities transactions and for the allocation of brokerage commissions in connection with such transactions. The Adviser’s primary consideration in effecting a security transaction is to obtain the best net price and the most favorable execution of the order. Purchases and sales of securities on a securities exchange are effected through brokers who charge negotiated commissions for their services. Orders may be directed to any broker to the extent and in the manner permitted by applicable law.

In the over-the-counter market, securities generally are traded on a “net” basis with dealers acting as principals for their own accounts without stated commissions, although the price of a security usually includes a profit to the dealer. In underwritten offerings, securities are bought at a fixed price that includes an amount of compensation to the underwriter, generally referred to as the underwriter’s “concession” or “discount.” On occasion, certain money market instruments may be bought directly from an issuer, in which case no commissions or discounts are paid.

In placing orders for portfolio securities of the Funds, the Adviser gives primary consideration to obtaining the best net prices and most favorable execution. This means that the Adviser will seek to execute each transaction at a price and commission, if any, which provides the most favorable total cost or proceeds reasonably attainable in the circumstances. In seeking such execution, the Adviser will use its best judgment in evaluating the terms of a transaction, and will give consideration to various relevant factors, including, without limitation, the size and type of the transaction, the nature and character of the market for the security, the confidentiality, speed and certainty of effective execution required for the transaction, the general execution and operational capabilities of the broker/dealer, the reputation, reliability, experience and financial condition of the broker/dealer, the value and quality of the services rendered by the broker/dealer in this instance and other transactions and the reasonableness of the spread or commission, if any. Research services received from broker/dealers supplement the Adviser’s own research and may include the following types of information: statistical and background information on industry groups and individual companies; forecasts and interpretations with respect to U.S. and foreign economies, securities, markets, specific industry groups and individual companies; information on political developments; Fund management strategies; performance information on securities and information concerning prices of securities; and information supplied by specialized services to the Adviser and to the Board with respect to the performance, investment activities and fees and expenses of other mutual funds. Such information may be communicated electronically, orally or in written form. Research services also may include the arranging of meetings with management of companies and the provision of access to consultants who supply research information.

The outside research is useful to the Adviser since, in certain instances, the broker/dealers utilized by the Adviser may follow a different universe of securities issuers and other matters than those that the Adviser’s staff can follow. In addition, this research provides the Adviser with a different perspective on financial markets, even if the securities research obtained relates to issues followed by the Adviser. Research services that are provided to the Adviser by broker/dealers are available for the benefit of all accounts managed or advised by the Adviser. In some cases, the research services are available only from the broker/dealer providing such services. In other cases, the research services may be obtainable from alternative sources. The Adviser is of the opinion that because the broker/dealer research supplements rather than replaces the Adviser’s own research, the receipt of such research does not tend to decrease the Adviser’s expenses, but tends to improve the quality of its investment advice. However, to the extent that the Adviser would have bought any such research services had such services not been provided by broker/dealers, the expenses of such services to the Adviser could be considered to have been reduced accordingly. Certain research services furnished by broker/dealers may be useful to the clients of the Adviser other than the Funds. Conversely, any research services received by the Adviser through the

 

120


Table of Contents

placement of transactions of other clients may be of value to the Adviser in fulfilling its obligations to the Funds. The Adviser is of the opinion that this material is beneficial in supplementing its research and analysis; and, therefore, it may benefit the Trust by improving the quality of the Adviser’s investment advice. The advisory fees paid by the Trust are not reduced because the Adviser receives such services.

Under Section 28(e) of the 1934 Act, the Adviser shall not be “deemed to have acted unlawfully or to have breached its fiduciary duty” solely because under certain circumstances it has caused the account to pay a higher commission than the lowest available. To obtain the benefit of Section 28(e), the Adviser must make a good faith determination that the commissions paid are “reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage and research services provided by such member, broker, or dealer, viewed in terms of either that particular transaction or his overall responsibilities with respect to the accounts as to which he exercises investment discretion.” Accordingly, the price to a Funds in any transaction may be less favorable than that available from another broker/dealer if the difference is reasonably justified by other aspects of the portfolio execution services offered. Some broker/dealers may indicate that the provision of research services is dependent upon the generation of certain specified levels of commissions and underwriting concessions by the Adviser’s clients, including the Funds.

Commission rates are established pursuant to negotiations with broker/dealers based on the quality and quantity of execution services provided by broker/dealers in light of generally prevailing rates. On exchanges on which commissions are negotiated, the cost of transactions may vary among different broker/dealers. Transactions on foreign stock exchanges involve payment of brokerage commissions that generally are fixed. Transactions in both foreign and domestic over-the-counter markets generally are principal transactions with dealers, and the costs of such transactions involve dealer spreads rather than brokerage commissions. With respect to over-the-counter transactions, the Adviser, where possible, will deal directly with dealers who make a market in the securities involved, except in those circumstances in which better prices and execution are available elsewhere.

In certain instances there may be securities that are suitable for a Fund as well as for one or more of the other clients of the Adviser. Investment decisions for the Funds and for the Adviser’s other clients are made with the goal of achieving their respective investment objectives. A particular security may be bought or sold for only one client even though it may be held by, or bought or sold for, other clients. Likewise, a particular security may be bought for one or more clients when one or more other clients are selling that same security. Some simultaneous transactions are inevitable when a number of accounts receive investment advice from the same investment adviser, particularly when the same security is suitable for the investment objectives of more than one client. When two or more clients are engaged simultaneously in the purchase or sale of the same security, the securities are allocated among clients in a manner believed to be equitable to each. In some cases, this policy could have a detrimental effect on the price or volume of the security in a particular transaction that may affect the Funds.

The Funds may participate, if and when practicable, in bidding for the purchase of portfolio securities directly from an issuer in order to take advantage of the lower purchase price available to members of a bidding group. A Fund will engage in this practice, however, only when the Adviser, in its sole discretion, believes such practice to be otherwise in such Fund’s interests.

The Trust will not execute portfolio transactions through, or buy or sell portfolio securities from or to, the Distributor, the Adviser, the Administrator or their affiliates acting as principal (including repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements), except to the extent permitted by applicable law, regulation or order. However, the Adviser is authorized to allocate buy and sell orders for portfolio securities to certain broker/dealers and financial institutions, including, in the case of agency transactions, broker/dealers and financial institutions that are affiliated with Ameriprise Financial. To the extent that a Fund executes any securities trades with an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial, such Fund does so in conformity with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act and the procedures that such Fund has adopted pursuant to the rule. In this regard, for each transaction, the Board will determine that: (i) the transaction resulted in prices for and execution of securities transactions at least as favorable to the particular Fund as those likely to be derived from a non-affiliated qualified broker/dealer; (ii) the affiliated broker/dealer charged the Fund commission rates consistent with those charged by the affiliated broker/dealer in similar transactions to clients comparable to the Fund and that are not affiliated with the broker/dealer in

 

121


Table of Contents

question; and (iii) the fees, commissions or other remuneration paid by the Fund did not exceed 2% of the sales price of the securities if the sale was effected in connection with a secondary distribution, or 1% of the purchase or sale price of such securities if effected in other than a secondary distribution.

Certain affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may have deposit, loan or commercial banking relationships with the corporate users of facilities financed by industrial development revenue bonds or private activity bonds bought by certain of the Columbia Funds. Ameriprise Financial or certain of its affiliates may serve as trustee, custodian, tender agent, guarantor, placement agent, underwriter, or in some other capacity, with respect to certain issues of securities. Under certain circumstances, a Fund may buy securities from a member of an underwriting syndicate in which an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial is a member. The Trust has adopted procedures pursuant to Rule 10f-3 under the 1940 Act, and intends to comply with the requirements of Rule 10f-3, in connection with any purchases of municipal securities that may be subject to Rule 10f-3.

Given the breadth of the Adviser’s investment management activities, investment decisions for the Funds are not always made independently from those for other funds, or other investment companies and accounts advised or managed by the Adviser. When a purchase or sale of the same security is made at substantially the same time on behalf of one or more of the Columbia Funds and another investment portfolio, investment company or account, the transaction will be averaged as to price and available investments allocated as to amount in a manner which the Adviser believes to be equitable to the Funds and such other funds, investment portfolio, investment company or account. In some instances, this investment procedure may adversely affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the position obtained or sold by the Fund. To the extent permitted by law, the Adviser may aggregate the securities to be sold or bought for the Funds with those to be sold or bought for other funds, investment portfolios, investment companies, or accounts in executing transactions.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about these and other conflicts of interest.

Brokerage Commissions

The following charts reflect the amounts of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated. In certain instances, the Funds may pay brokerage commissions to broker/dealers that are affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. As indicated above, all such transactions involving the payment of brokerage commissions to affiliates are done in compliance with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act.

Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds

The following charts reflect the aggregate amount of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recent fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated. Differences, year to year, in the amount of brokerage commissions paid by a Fund were primarily the result of increased market volatility as well as shareholder purchase and redemption activity in the Fund.

 

Fund

  Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010
    Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009
    Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008
 

Bond Fund

    —        $ 7,631      $ 1,313   

Corporate Income Fund

  $ 16,910      $ 40,205      $ 41,873   

Emerging Markets Fund

  $ 1,613,790      $ 1,857,556      $ 409,305   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

  $ 4,604,246      $ 4,051,236      $ 1,575,505   

Intermediate Bond Fund

  $ 72,932      $ 160,852      $ 251,534   

Pacific/Asia Fund

  $ 121,276      $ 249,437      $ 144,244   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  $ 1,269,007      $ 1,221,132      $ 399,105   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

    —          —          —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

  $ 2,433,201      $ 4,287,837      $ 2,688,134   

 

122


Table of Contents

Fund

  Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
    Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009
    Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

    —          —          —     

Strategic Income Fund

    —          —          —     

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended
May 31, 2009
 

International Bond Fund

   $ 7,557         —     

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

     —         $ 7,745       $ 38,343   

Small Cap Value Fund I

   $ 1,771,335       $ 1,761,043       $ 1,768,277   

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008
 

Balanced Fund

   $ 1,940       $ 358,996       $ 367   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   $ 3,436,137       $ 4,070,265       $ 4,499,159   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   $ 4,948,857       $ 2,979,089       $ 1,860,445   

Strategic Investor Fund

   $ 1,505,109       $ 2,168,357       $ 2,202,923   

 

* Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007
 

Contrarian Core Fund

   $ 1,108,739       $ 837,955       $ 875,499   

Dividend Income Fund

   $ 1,224,272       $ 300,918       $ 252,732   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 3,113,714       $ 3,752,464       $ 4,695,947   

Small Cap Core Fund

   $ 401,075       $ 783,011       $ 1,357,590   

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   $ 215       $ 2,063.75       $ 5,041   

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 205,056       $ 770,227       $ 575,797       $ 1,245,494   

Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds to Certain Broker/Dealers

The Funds paid no brokerage commissions to affiliated broker/dealers for the three most recently completed fiscal years.

Directed Brokerage

The Funds or the Adviser, through an agreement or understanding with a broker/dealer, or otherwise through an internal allocation procedure, may direct, subject to applicable legal requirements, the Funds’ brokerage transactions to a broker/dealer because of the research services it provides the Funds or the Adviser.

 

123


Table of Contents

 

During each Fund’s last fiscal year, the Funds directed certain brokerage transactions and paid related commissions in the amounts as follows:

 

Fund

   Amount of
Transactions
     Related
Commissions
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

     

Bond Fund

     —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

     —           —     

Emerging Markets Fund

   $ 40,833,479       $ 96,869   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   $ 1,577,703,004       $ 1,174,934   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     —           —     

Pacific/Asia Fund

   $ 6,528,634       $ 16,526   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 215,687,831       $ 123,292   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     —           —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

   $ 94,434,776       $ 109,144   

For Funds with fiscal year ended May 31, 2010

     

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     —           —     

Strategic Income Fund

     —           —     

International Bond Fund

     —           —     

For Funds with fiscal year ended June 30, 2010

     

High Yield Municipal Fund

     —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

   $ 243,711,788       $ 379,141   

For Funds with fiscal year ended August 31, 2010*

     

Balanced Fund

     —           —     

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   $ 883,671,820       $ 882,670   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   $ 552,521,922       $ 755,567   

Strategic Investor Fund

   $ 352,498,218       $ 387,370   

For Funds with fiscal year ended September 30, 2009

     

Contrarian Core Fund

   $ 868,244,017       $ 158,344   

Dividend Income Fund

   $ 1,205,420,394       $ 245,382   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 3,319,677,698       $ 317,931   

Small Cap Core Fund

   $ 123,921,233       $ 7,888   

For the Fund with fiscal year ended October 31, 2009

     

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     —           —     

For the Fund with fiscal year ended August 31, 2009 and fiscal period ended December 31, 2009, respectively

     

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 548,639,648       $ 128,657   

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 176,752,302       $ 10,022   

 

* Unaudited.

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

In certain cases, the Funds, as part of their principal investment strategies, or otherwise as a permissible investment, will invest in the common stock or debt obligations of the regular broker/dealers that the Adviser uses to transact brokerage for the Funds.

 

124


Table of Contents

 

As of each Fund’s fiscal year end, the Funds owned securities of their “regular brokers or dealers” or their parents, as defined in Rule 10b-1 under the 1940 Act, as shown in the table below:

Investments in Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

 

Fund

  

Broker/Dealer

   Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

  

Bond Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc    $ 24,282,998   
   Barclays Capital    $ 847,993   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 3,211,139   
   Deutsche Bank AG    $ 819,793   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 8,744,405   
   UBS Warburg LLC    $ 9,489,194   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 3,182,799   

Corporate Income Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 3,407,339   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 10,063,708   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 626,052   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 12,494,578   

Emerging Markets Fund

   None    $ 0   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   None    $ 0   

Intermediate Bond Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 2,552,425   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 41,593,132   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 33,863,433   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 21,911,658   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 72,066,818   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 39,657,747   

Pacific/Asia Fund

   None    $ 0   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   None    $ 0   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

   None    $ 0   

Value and Restructuring Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 127,537,500   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 106,908,500   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 141,622,900   
   Citigroup, Inc    $ 22,547,800   

For Funds with fiscal year ended May 31, 2010

  

High Yield Opportunity Fund

   None    $ 0   

International Bond Fund

   None    $ 0   

Strategic Income Fund

   Citigroup, Inc    $ 21,350,102   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 12,268,572   
   Barclays Capital    $ 3,127,149   
   Deutsche Bank AG    $ 12,787,838   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 9,796,852   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 8,795,329   

For Funds with fiscal year ended June 30, 2010

  

High Yield Municipal Fund

   None    $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund I

   Piper Jaffray Companies, Inc.    $ 6,315,184   

 

125


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Broker/Dealer

   Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended August 31, 2010

  

Balanced Fund

  

Goldman Sachs & Co.

   $ 4,701,785   
  

State Street Corp.

   $ 2,838,147   
  

JPMorgan Chase & Co.

   $ 10,066,956   
  

Citigroup, Inc.

   $ 3,196,652   
  

Deutsche Bank AG

   $ 539,763   
  

Barclays Capital

   $ 561,638   
  

Salomon Brothers Holdings, Inc.

   $ 1,440,381   
  

CS First Boston Corp.

   $ 2,340,563   
  

Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.

   $ 2,559,873   
  

UBS Warburg LLC

   $ 1,720,960   
  

Royal Bank of Scotland PLC

   $ 430,160   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

  

None

   $ 0   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

  

None

   $ 0   

Strategic Investor Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 7,979,314   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 14,732,745   

For Funds with fiscal year ended September 30, 2009

  

Contrarian Core Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 6,768,896   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 11,790,735   
   State Street Corp.    $ 7,774,280   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 9,770,550   

Dividend Income Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 47,544,700   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 17,910,400   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 10,434,210   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 19,525,424   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 9,644,782   

Small Cap Core Fund

   None    $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal year ended October 31, 2009

  

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   None    $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal period ended December 31, 2009

  

Real Estate Equity Fund

   None    $ 0   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

The Funds, along with the Transfer Agent and/or the Distributor and the Adviser, may pay significant amounts to financial intermediaries (as defined below), including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for providing the types of services that would typically be provided directly by a mutual fund’s transfer agent. The level of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. A number of factors may be considered in determining payments to a financial intermediary, including, without limitation, the nature of the services provided to shareholders or retirement plan participants that invest in the Funds through retirement plans. These services may include sub-accounting, sub-transfer agency or similar recordkeeping services, shareholder or participant reporting, shareholder or participant transaction processing, and/or the provision of call center support (additional shareholder services). These payments for shareholder servicing support with respect to the Columbia Funds vary by financial intermediary but generally are not expected, with certain limited exceptions, to exceed 0.40% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan, and 0.45% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that do not pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan. The Board has authorized each Fund to pay up to 0.15% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares. Such payments will be made by a Fund to the Transfer Agent who will in turn make payments to the financial intermediary for the provision of such additional shareholder services. The Funds’ Transfer Agent, Distributor or their affiliates will pay, from its or their own resources, amounts in excess of the amount paid by the Funds to financial intermediaries in connection with the provision of these additional shareholder services and other services.

 

126


Table of Contents

 

For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment advisor, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Funds also may make additional payments to financial intermediaries that charge networking fees for certain services provided in connection with the maintenance of shareholder accounts through the NSCC.

In addition, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may make lump sum payments to selected financial intermediaries receiving shareholder servicing payments in reimbursement of printing costs for literature for participants, account maintenance fees or fees for establishment of the Funds on the financial intermediary’s system or other similar services.

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates had agreed to make shareholder servicing payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

Recipients of Shareholder Servicing Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

Acclaim Benefits, Inc.

   

A.G. Edwards

   

Alerus Retirement Solutions

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Benefit Plan Administrators

   

Bisys Retirement Services

   

Charles Schwab & Co.

   

Charles Schwab Trust Co.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

CitiStreet LLC

   

City National Bank

   

Compensation & Capital Administrative Services, Inc.

   

CPI Qualified Plan Consultants

   

Daily Access Concepts, Inc.

   

Digital Retirement Solutions

   

Dreyfus

   

Edward D. Jones & Co., L.P.

   

E*Trade Group, Inc.

   

ExpertPlan

   

Fidelity Investments Institutional Operations Co.

   

First Clearing LLC

   

Genworth Financial

   

GPC Securities, Inc.

   

Guardian Life Insurance Company

   

GWFS Equities, Inc.

   

Hartford Life Insurance Company

   

Hewitt Associates LLC

   

ICMA Retirement Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Company

   

ING Institutional Plan Services, LLP

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company (USA)

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company of New York

   

JP Morgan Retirement Plan Services LLC

   

Lincoln Financial Group

   

LPL Financial Corporation

   

Marshall & Illsley Trust Company

   

Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company

   

Matrix Settlement & Clearance Services

   

Mercer HR Services, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Mid Atlantic Capital Corporation

   

Morgan Keegan & Co., Inc.

   

Morgan Stanley & Co., Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Investor Services Corp.

   

Newport Retirement Services, Inc.

   

New York State Deferred Compensation Plan

   

NYLife Distributors LLC

   

PNC Advisors

   

Princeton Retirement Group

   

Principal Life Insurance Company

   

Prudential Insurance Company of America

   

Prudential Retirement Insurance & Annuity Co.

   

Reliance Trust Company


 

127


Table of Contents
   

Robert W. Baird & Co., Inc.

   

Royal Alliance Associates, Inc.

   

Standard Retirement Services, Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Clearing Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Trust Company

   

Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association of America

   

The 401k Company

   

T. Rowe Price Group, Inc.

   

The Vanguard Group, Inc.

   

Unified Trust Company, N.A.

   

UPromise Investments, Inc.

   

VALIC Retirement Services

   

Wachovia Bank, N.A.

   

Wachovia Securities, LLC

   

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management, LLC

   

Wilmington Trust Corporation

   

Wilmington Trust Retirement & Institutional Services Company


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

Financial intermediaries may receive different commissions, sales charge reallowances and other payments with respect to sales of different classes of shares of the Funds. These other payments may include servicing payments to retirement plan administrators and other institutions at rates up to those described above under Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment adviser, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may pay additional compensation to selected financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, under the categories described below. These categories are not mutually exclusive, and a single financial intermediary may receive payments under all categories. A financial intermediary also may receive payments described above in Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. These payments may create an incentive for a financial intermediary or its representatives to recommend or offer shares of a Fund to its customers. The amount of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. In determining the amount of payments to be made, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may consider a number of factors, including, without limitation, asset mix and length of relationship with the financial intermediary, the size of the customer/shareholder base of the financial intermediary, the manner in which customers of the financial intermediary make investments in the Funds, the nature and scope of marketing support or services provided by the financial intermediary (as described more fully below) and the costs incurred by the financial intermediary in connection with maintaining the infrastructure necessary or desirable to support investments in the Funds.

These additional payments by the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates are made pursuant to agreements between the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates and financial intermediaries, and do not change the price paid by investors for the purchase of a share, the amount a Fund will receive as proceeds from such sales or the distribution fees and expenses paid by the Fund as shown under the heading Fees and Expenses of the Fund in the Fund’s prospectuses.

Marketing Support Payments

The Distributor and the Adviser may make payments, from their own resources, to certain financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for marketing support services relating to the Columbia Funds, including, but not limited to, business planning assistance, educating financial intermediary

 

128


Table of Contents

personnel about the Funds and shareholder financial planning needs, placement on the financial intermediary’s preferred or recommended fund list or otherwise identifying the Funds as being part of a complex to be accorded a higher degree of marketing support than complexes not making such payments, access to sales meetings, sales representatives and management representatives of the financial intermediary, client servicing and systems infrastructure support. These payments are generally based upon one or more of the following factors: average net assets of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, gross sales of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, reimbursement of ticket charges (fees that a financial intermediary firm charges its representatives for effecting transactions in fund shares) or a negotiated lump sum payment.

While the financial arrangements may vary for each financial intermediary, the marketing support payments to each financial intermediary generally are expected to be between 0.05% and 0.50% on an annual basis for payments based on average net assets of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary, and between 0.05% and 0.25% on an annual basis for firms receiving a payment based on gross sales of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary. The Distributor and affiliates may make payments in materially larger amounts or on a basis materially different from those described above when dealing with certain financial intermediaries. Such increased payments may enable the financial intermediaries to offset credits that they may provide to their customers.

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or the Adviser had agreed to make marketing support payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

Recipients of Marketing Support Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

AIG Advisor Group

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

AXA Advisors, LLC

   

Banc of America Investment Services, Inc.

   

Banc of America Securities LLC

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Bank of New York

   

Citibank, N.A.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

Commonwealth Financial Network

   

Custodial Trust Company

   

Fidelity Brokerage Services, Inc.

   

Genworth Financial, Inc.

   

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

   

GunAllen Financial, Inc.

   

Harris Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Co.

   

J.J.B. Hilliard, W.L. Lyons, Inc.

   

J.P. Morgan Clearing Corp.

   

Liberty Life Insurance Co.

   

Lincoln Financial Advisors Corp.

   

Linsco/Private Ledger Corp.

   

Mellon Financial Markets, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Financial Services LLC

   

Pershing LLC

   

Prudential Investment Management Services, LLC

   

Raymond James & Associates, Inc.

   

Raymond James Financial Services, Inc.

   

SEI Investments Inc.

   

State Street Global Markets, LLC

   

Transamerica Corporation

   

UBS Financial Services Inc.

   

US Bank National Association

   

Wachovia Securities LLC

   

Webster Investment Services, Inc.

   

Wells Fargo Corporate Trust Services

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management LLC

   

Wells Fargo Investments, LLC


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or the Adviser may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

 

129


Table of Contents

 

Other Payments

From time to time, the Distributor, from its own resources, may provide additional compensation to certain financial intermediaries that sell or arrange for the sale of shares of the Funds to the extent not prohibited by laws or the rules of any self-regulatory agency, such as the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA). Such compensation provided by the Distributor may include financial assistance to financial intermediaries that enable the Distributor to participate in and/or present at financial intermediary-sponsored conferences or seminars, sales or training programs for invited registered representatives and other financial intermediary employees, financial intermediary entertainment and other financial intermediary-sponsored events, and travel expenses, including lodging incurred by registered representatives and other employees in connection with prospecting, retention and due diligence trips. The Distributor makes payments for entertainment events it deems appropriate, subject to the Distributor’s internal guidelines and applicable law. These payments may vary depending upon the nature of the event.

Your financial intermediary may charge you fees or commissions in addition to those disclosed in this SAI. You should consult with your financial intermediary and review carefully any disclosure your financial intermediary provides regarding its services and compensation. Depending on the financial arrangement in place at any particular time, a financial intermediary and its financial consultants may have a financial incentive for recommending a particular fund or a particular share class over other funds or share classes. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information.

 

130


Table of Contents

 

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

Description of the Trust’s Shares

The Funds offer shares in the classes shown in the table below. Subject to certain limited exceptions discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses, a Fund may no longer be accepting new investments from current shareholders or prospective investors. The Funds, however, may at any time and without notice, offer any of these classes to the general public for investment.

The Trust’s Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust (Declaration of Trust) permits it to issue an unlimited number of full and fractional shares of beneficial interest of each Fund, without par value, and to divide or combine the shares of any series into a greater or lesser number of shares of that Fund without thereby changing the proportionate beneficial interests in that Fund and to divide such shares into classes. Each share of a class of a Fund represents an equal proportional interest in that Fund with each other share in the same class and is entitled to such distributions out of the income earned on the assets belonging to that Fund as are declared in the discretion of the Board. However, different share classes of a Fund pay different distribution amounts because each share class has different expenses. Each time a distribution is made, the net asset value per share of the share class is reduced by the amount of the distribution.

Share Classes Offered by the Funds

 

Fund

  Class A
Shares
    Class  Ba
Shares
    Class C
Shares
    Class I
Shares
    Class R
Shares
    Class R4
Shares
    Class R5
Shares
    Class T
Shares
    Class W
Shares
    Class Y
Shares
    Class Z
Shares
    Other  

Balanced Fund

  ü        ü        ü          ü        ü c      ü c            ü       

Bond Fund

  ü        ü c      ü        ü              ü c      ü        ü        ü       

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

  ü        ü        ü                      ü       

Contrarian Core Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü c        ü        ü          ü       

Corporate Income Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü                ü          ü       

Dividend Income Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü            ü        ü          ü       

Emerging Markets Fund

  ü          ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

  ü        ü c      ü        ü        ü        ü c              ü       

High Yield Municipal Fund

  ü        ü        ü                      ü       

High Yield Opportunity Fund

  ü        ü        ü                      ü       

Intermediate Bond Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

International Bond Fund

  ü          ü        ü                    ü       

Large Cap Growth Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü c      ü c      ü        ü        ü        ü        ü b   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü c      ü        ü        ü        ü       

Pacific/Asia Fund

  ü          ü        ü                    ü       

Real Estate Equity Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü c      ü c        ü          ü       

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  ü          ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

Small Cap Core Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü              ü        ü          ü       

Small Cap Growth Fund I

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü                ü        ü       

Small Cap Value Fund I

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü                ü        ü       

Strategic Income Fund

  ü        ü        ü          ü        ü c      ü c        ü          ü       

Strategic Investor Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü              ü        ü        ü       

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü                    ü       

Value and Restructuring Fund

  ü          ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

 

a

Class B shares of the Funds are closed to new investments, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares. Additional Class B shares of the Funds will be issued only in connection with (i) reinvestment of dividends and/or capital gain distributions in Class B shares of the Funds by the Funds’ existing Class B shareholders and (ii) exchanges by shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Columbia Fund for Class B shares of the Funds. See the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds for details.

b

The Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund also offers Class E shares and Class F shares. See the prospectuses for Class E shares and Class F shares for details.

c

Classes have not yet commenced operations as of the date of this SAI.

 

131


Table of Contents

 

Restrictions on Holding or Disposing of Shares

There are no restrictions on the right of shareholders to retain or dispose of the Funds’ shares, other than the possible future termination of the Funds. The Funds may be terminated by reorganization into another mutual fund or by liquidation and distribution of their assets. Unless terminated by reorganization or liquidation, the Funds will continue indefinitely.

Liability

Under Massachusetts law, shareholders could, under certain circumstances, be held personally liable for the obligations of the Trust. However, the Trust’s Declaration of Trust disclaims any shareholder liability for acts or obligations of the Funds and the Trust and requires that notice of such disclaimer be given in each agreement, obligation, or instrument entered into or executed by a Fund or the Trustees. The Declaration of Trust provides for indemnification out of Fund property for all loss and expense of any shareholder held personally liable for the obligations of a Fund. Thus, the risk of a shareholder incurring financial loss on account of shareholder liability is limited to circumstances (which are considered remote) in which a Fund would be unable to meet its obligations and the disclaimer was inoperative.

The risk of a Fund incurring financial loss on account of another series of the Trust also is believed to be remote, because it would be limited to circumstances in which the disclaimer was inoperative and the other series of the Trust was unable to meet its obligations.

Dividend Rights

The shareholders of a Fund are entitled to receive any dividends or other distributions declared for the Fund. No shares have priority or preference over any other shares of a Fund with respect to distributions. Distributions will be made from the assets of a Fund, and will be paid pro rata to all shareholders of the Fund (or class) according to the number of shares of the Fund (or class) held by shareholders on the record date. The amount of income dividends per share may vary between separate share classes of a Fund based upon differences in the way that expenses are allocated between share classes pursuant to a multiple class plan.

Voting Rights and Shareholder Meetings

The Trust is not required to hold annual shareholder meetings, but special meetings may be called for certain purposes. The Trust voluntarily has undertaken to hold a shareholder meeting at which the Board would be elected at least every five years beginning in 2005. Each whole share (or fractional share) outstanding on the record date established in accordance with the Trust’s By-Laws shall be entitled to a number of votes on any matter on which it is entitled to vote equal to the net asset value of the share (or fractional share) in U.S. dollars determined at the close of business on the record date (for example, a share having a net asset value of $10.50 would be entitled to 10.5 votes).

The Trustees may fill any vacancies on the Board except that the Trustees may not fill a vacancy if, immediately after filling such vacancy, less than two-thirds of the Trustees then in office would have been elected to such office by the shareholders. In addition, at such times as less than a majority of the Trustees then in office have been elected to such office by the shareholders, the Trustees must call a meeting of shareholders. Trustees may be removed from office by a written consent signed by holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of the Trust or by a vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares at a meeting duly called for the purpose. Except as otherwise disclosed in a Fund’s prospectuses and this SAI, the Trustees shall continue to hold office and may appoint their successors.

At any shareholders’ meetings that may be held, shareholders of all series would vote together, irrespective of series, on the election of Trustees, but each series would vote separately from the others on other matters, such as changes in the investment policies of that series or the approval of the management agreement for that series.

 

132


Table of Contents

Shares of the Fund and any other series of the Trust that may be in existence from time to time generally vote together except when required by law to vote separately by Fund or by class.

Liquidation Rights

In the event of the liquidation or dissolution of the Trust or the Funds, shareholders of the Funds are entitled to receive the assets attributable to the relevant class of shares of the Funds that are available for distribution and to a distribution of any general assets not attributable to a particular investment portfolio that are available for distribution in such manner and on such basis as the Board may determine.

Preemptive Rights

There are no preemptive rights associated with Fund shares.

Conversion Rights

With the exception of Class B shares, which no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares as described in the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds, shareholders have the right, which is subject to change by the Board, to convert or “exchange” shares of one class for another. Such right is outlined and subject to certain conditions set forth in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Redemptions

Each Fund’s dividend, distribution and redemption policies can be found in its prospectuses under the headings Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares and Distributions and Taxes. However, the Board may suspend the right of shareholders to sell shares when permitted or required to do so by law or compel sales of shares in certain cases.

Sinking Fund Provisions

The Trust has no sinking fund provisions.

Calls or Assessment

All Fund shares are issued in uncertificated form only and when issued will be fully paid and non-assessable by the Trust.

 

133


Table of Contents

 

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

Purchase and Redemption

An investor may buy, sell and exchange shares in the Funds utilizing the methods, and subject to the restrictions, described in the Funds’ prospectuses. The following information supplements information in the Funds’ prospectuses.

The Funds have authorized one or more broker/dealers to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. These broker/dealers are authorized to designate other intermediaries to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. The Funds will be deemed to have received a buy or sell order when an authorized broker/dealer, or, if applicable, a broker/dealer’s authorized designee, accepts the order. Customer orders will be priced at each Fund’s net asset value next computed after they are accepted by an authorized broker/dealer or the broker’s authorized designee.

The Trust also may make payment for sales in readily marketable securities or other property if it is appropriate to do so in light of the Trust’s responsibilities under the 1940 Act.

Under the 1940 Act, the Funds may suspend the right of redemption or postpone the date of payment for shares during any period when (i) trading on the NYSE is restricted by applicable rules and regulations of the SEC; (ii) the NYSE is closed for other than customary weekend and holiday closings; (iii) the SEC has by order permitted such suspension; (iv) an emergency exists as determined by the SEC. (The Funds may also suspend or postpone the recordation of the transfer of their shares upon the occurrence of any of the foregoing conditions).

The Trust has elected to be governed by Rule 18f–1 under the 1940 Act, as a result of which each Fund is obligated to redeem shares, subject to the exceptions listed above, with respect to any one shareholder during any 90-day period, solely in cash up to the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the net asset value of each Fund at the beginning of the period.

Tax-Advantaged Retirement Plans (Retirement Plans)

The Transfer Agent maintains prototype tax-qualified plans, including Pension and Profit-Sharing Plans, for individuals, corporations, employees and the self-employed. The minimum initial Retirement Plan investment is $1,000, applied at the plan level. BANA is the custodian/trustee and plan sponsor of the Columbia Management prototype plans offered through the Distributor. In general a $20 annual fee is charged. Participants in Retirement Plans not sponsored by BANA, not including IRAs, may be subject to an annual fee of $20 unless the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account with the Transfer Agent. Participants in BANA sponsored prototype plans (other than IRAs) who liquidate the total value of their account may also be charged a $20 close-out processing fee payable to the Transfer Agent. The close-out fee applies to plans opened after September 1, 1996. The fee is in addition to any applicable CDSC. The fee will not apply if the participant uses the proceeds to open a Columbia Management IRA Rollover account in any fund distributed by the Distributor, or if the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account. Consultation with a competent financial advisor regarding these Retirement Plans and consideration of the suitability of fund shares as an investment under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or otherwise is recommended.

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

134


Table of Contents

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares (other than Columbia Money Market Fund or Columbia Government Money Market Fund) within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

 

135


Table of Contents

 

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.
** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares, Class R5 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

136


Table of Contents

 

Anti-Money Laundering Compliance

The Funds are required to comply with various anti-money laundering laws and regulations. Consequently, the Funds may request additional required information from you to verify your identity. Your application will be rejected if it does not contain your name, social security number, date of birth and permanent street address. If at any time the Funds believe a shareholder may be involved in suspicious activity or if certain account information matches information on government lists of suspicious persons, the Funds may choose not to establish a new account or may be required to “freeze” a shareholder’s account. The Funds also may be required to provide a governmental agency with information about transactions that have occurred in a shareholder’s account or to transfer monies received to establish a new account, transfer an existing account or transfer the proceeds of an existing account to a governmental agency. In some circumstances, the law may not permit the Funds to inform the shareholder that it has taken the actions described above.

Offering Price

The share price of each Fund is based on each Fund’s net asset value per share, which is calculated separately for each class of shares as of the close of regular trading on the NYSE (which is usually 4:00 p.m. Eastern time unless the NYSE closes earlier) on each day the Funds are open for business, unless the Board determines otherwise.

The value of each Fund’s portfolio securities for which a market quotation is available is determined in accordance with the Trust’s valuation procedures. In general terms, the valuation procedures provide that domestic exchange traded securities (other than NASDAQ listed equity securities) generally will be valued at their last traded sale prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. If no sales of those securities are reported on a particular day on the principal exchange, the securities generally will be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. Securities traded on a foreign securities exchange will generally be valued at their last sale prices on the exchange where the securities are primarily traded, or in the absence of a reported sale on a particular day, at their bid prices (in the case of securities held long) or ask prices (in the case of securities held short) as reported by that exchange. Securities traded primarily on NASDAQ will generally be valued at the NASDAQ Official Closing Price (NOCP) (which is the last trade price at or before 4:00:02 p.m. (Eastern Time) adjusted up to NASDAQ’s best bid price if the last trade price is below such bid price or adjusted down to NASDAQ’s best ask price if the last trade price is above such ask price). If no NOCP is available, the security will generally be valued at the last sale price shown on NASDAQ prior to the calculation of the NAV of the Fund. If no sale price is shown on NASDAQ, the latest bid price will be used. If no sale price is shown and no latest bid price is available, the price will be deemed “stale” and the value will be determined in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

Securities not traded upon any exchange will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices based upon quotes furnished by the appropriate market makers. If quoted prices are unavailable or are believed to be inaccurate, market values will generally be determined based on quotes obtained from one or more broker(s) or dealer(s) or based on a price obtained from a reputable independent pricing service.

Financial futures will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price. Forward foreign currency contracts will generally be valued using market quotations from a widely used quotation system that reflects the current cost of covering or off-setting the contract. Exchange traded options will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price on their exchange. If there is no reported sale on the valuation date, the options will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices.

Over-the-counter derivatives will generally be valued at fair value in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

 

137


Table of Contents

 

Repurchase agreements will generally be valued at a price equal to the amount of the cash invested in the repurchase agreement at the time of valuation. The market value of the securities underlying a repurchase agreement will be determined in accordance with the procedures above, as appropriate, for the purpose of determining the adequacy of collateral.

Shares of open-end investment companies held in each Fund’s portfolio will generally be valued at the latest net asset value reported by the investment company.

Debt securities will generally be valued by a pricing service which may employ a matrix or other indications of value, including but not limited to broker quotes, to determine valuations for normal institutional size trading units. The matrix can take into account various factors including, without limitation, bids, yield spreads, and/or other market data and specific security characteristics (e.g., credit quality, maturity and coupon rate). Debt securities for which a pricing service does not furnish valuations and for which market quotations are readily available will generally be valued based on the mean of the latest bid prices obtained from one or more dealers. Debt securities with remaining maturities of 60 days or less will, absent unusual circumstances, be valued at amortized cost.

Securities for which market quotations are not readily available for any reason, including that the latest quotation is deemed unreliable or unreasonable, securities and other assets and liabilities are valued at “fair value” as determined in good faith by the Adviser’s valuation committee. In general, any one or more of the following factors may be taken into account in determining fair value: the fundamental analytical data relating to the security; the value of other financial instruments, including derivative securities, traded on other markets or among dealers; trading volumes on markets, exchanges, or among dealers; values of baskets of securities traded on other markets; changes in interest rates; observations from financial institutions; government (domestic or foreign) actions or pronouncements; other news events; information as to any transactions or offers with respect to the security; price and extent of public trading in similar securities of the issuer or comparable companies; nature and expected duration of the event, if any, giving rise to the valuation issue; pricing history of the security; the relative size of the position in the portfolio; and other relevant information.

With respect to securities traded on foreign markets, the following factors also may be relevant: the value of foreign securities traded on other foreign markets; ADR trading; closed-end fund trading; foreign currency exchange activity; and the trading of financial products that are tied to baskets of foreign securities, such as World Equity Benchmark Shares.

The Board has determined, and the valuation procedures provide, that in certain circumstances it may be necessary to use an alternative valuation method, such as in-kind redemptions with affiliated benefit plans where the Department of Labor requires that valuation to be done in accordance with Rule 17a-7 of the 1940 Act.

 

138


Table of Contents

 

TAXATION

The following information supplements and should be read in conjunction with the section in the Funds’ prospectuses entitled “Distributions and Taxes.” The prospectuses generally describe the U.S. federal income tax treatment of distributions by the Funds. This section of the SAI provides additional information concerning U.S. federal income taxes. It is based on the Code, applicable Treasury Regulations, judicial authority, and administrative rulings and practice, all as in effect as of the date of this SAI and all of which are subject to change, including changes with retroactive effect. Except as specifically set forth below, the following discussion does not address any state, local or foreign tax matters.

A shareholder’s tax treatment may vary depending upon his or her particular situation. This discussion applies only to shareholders holding Fund shares as capital assets within the meaning of the Code. Except as otherwise noted, it may not apply to certain types of shareholders who may be subject to special rules, such as insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, shareholders holding Fund shares through tax-advantaged accounts (such as 401(k) Plan Accounts or Individual Retirement Accounts), financial institutions, broker-dealers, entities that are not organized under the laws of the United States or a political subdivision thereof, persons who are neither citizens nor residents of the United States, shareholders holding Fund shares as part of a hedge, straddle, or conversion transaction, and shareholders who are subject to the U.S. federal alternative minimum tax.

The Trust has not requested and will not request an advance ruling from the IRS as to the U.S. federal income tax matters described below. The IRS could adopt positions contrary to those discussed below and such positions could be sustained. In addition, the following discussion and the discussions in the prospectuses applicable to each shareholder address only some of the U.S. federal income tax considerations generally affecting investments in the Funds. Prospective shareholders are urged to consult with their own tax advisors and financial planners regarding the U.S. federal tax consequences of an investment in a Fund, the application of state, local, or foreign laws, and the effect of any possible changes in applicable tax laws on their investment in the Funds.

Qualification as a Regulated Investment Company

It is intended that each Fund qualify as a “regulated investment company” under Subchapter M of Subtitle A, Chapter 1 of the Code. Each Fund will be treated as a separate entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Thus, the provisions of the Code applicable to regulated investment companies generally will apply separately to each Fund, even though each Fund is a series of the Trust. Furthermore, each Fund will separately determine its income, gains, losses, and expenses for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

In order to qualify for the special tax treatment accorded regulated investment companies and their shareholders, each Fund must, among other things, derive at least 90% of its gross income each taxable year generally from (i) dividends, interest, certain payments with respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities or foreign currencies, or other income attributable to its business of investing in such stock, securities or foreign currencies (including, but not limited to, gains from options, futures or forward contracts) and (ii) net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership, as defined below. In general, for purposes of this 90% gross income requirement, income derived from a partnership (other than a qualified publicly traded partnership) will be treated as qualifying income only to the extent such income is attributable to items of income of the partnership which would be qualifying income if realized directly by the regulated investment company. However, 100% of the net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership (defined as a partnership (x) the interests in which are traded on an established securities market or readily tradable on a secondary market or the substantial equivalent thereof, (y) that derives at least 90% of its income from the passive income sources defined in Code Section 7704(d), and (z) that derives less than 90% of its income from the qualifying income described in clause (i) above) will be treated as qualifying income. Certain of a Fund’s investments in master limited partnerships (MLPs), if any, may

 

139


Table of Contents

qualify as interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, although in general the passive loss rules do not apply to a regulated investment company, such rules do apply to a regulated investment company with respect to items attributable to an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership.

Each Fund must also diversify its holdings so that, at the end of each quarter of the Fund’s taxable year: (i) at least 50% of the fair market value of its total assets consists of (A) cash and cash items (including receivables), U.S. government securities and securities of other regulated investment companies, and (B) securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (A)) to the extent such securities do not exceed 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets and are not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (ii) not more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s total assets consists of the securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (i)(A)), the securities of two or more issuers the Fund controls and which are engaged in the same, similar, or related trades or businesses, or the securities of one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, for purposes of meeting this diversification requirement, the term “outstanding voting securities of such issuer” includes the equity securities of a qualified publicly traded partnership and in the case of a Fund’s investments in loan participations, the Fund shall treat both the financial intermediary and the issuer of the underlying loan as an issuer. The qualifying income and diversification requirements described above may limit the extent to which a Fund can engage in certain derivative transactions, as well as the extent to which it can invest in MLPs.

In addition, each Fund generally must distribute to its shareholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income for the taxable year, which generally includes its ordinary income and the excess of any net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss, and at least 90% of its net tax-exempt interest income (if any) for the taxable year.

If a Fund qualifies as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment, it generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on any of the investment company taxable income and net capital gain (i.e., the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) it distributes to its shareholders (including Capital Gain Dividends, as defined below). Each Fund generally intends to distribute at least annually substantially all of its investment company taxable income (computed without regard to the dividends-paid deduction) and substantially all of its net capital gain. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to U.S. federal income taxation. Any investment company taxable income retained by a Fund will be subject to tax at regular corporate rates.

In addition, although each Fund generally intends to distribute all of its net capital gain, a Fund may determine to retain for investment all or a portion of its net capital gain. If a Fund retains any net capital gain, it will be subject to a tax at regular corporate rates on the amount retained, but may designate the retained amount as undistributed capital gains in a notice to its shareholders, who (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as long-term capital gain, their shares of such undistributed amount, and (ii) will be entitled to credit their proportionate shares of the tax paid by the Fund on such undistributed amount against their U.S. federal income tax liabilities, if any, and to claim refunds to the extent the credit exceeds such liabilities. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, the tax basis of shares owned by a shareholder of a Fund will be increased by an amount equal under current law to the difference between the amount of undistributed capital gains included in the shareholder’s gross income under clause (i) of the preceding sentence and the tax deemed paid by the shareholder under clause (ii) of the preceding sentence.

In determining its net capital gain for Capital Gain Dividend purposes, a regulated investment company generally must treat any net capital loss or any net long-term capital loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year. Treasury Regulations generally permit a regulated investment company, in determining its taxable income, to elect to treat all or part of any net capital loss, any net long-term capital loss or any foreign currency loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year.

 

140


Table of Contents

 

In order to comply with the distribution requirements described above applicable to regulated investment companies, a Fund generally must make the distributions in the same taxable year that it realizes the income and gain, although in certain circumstances, a Fund may make the distributions in the following taxable year in respect of income and gains from the prior taxable year. Shareholders generally are taxed on any distributions from a Fund in the year they are actually distributed. If a Fund declares a distribution to shareholders of record in October, November or December of one calendar year and pays the distribution by January 31 of the following calendar year, however, the Fund and its shareholders will be treated as if the Fund paid the distribution by December 31 of the earlier year.

If, for any taxable year, a Fund fails to qualify as a regulated investment company accorded special tax treatment under the Code, it will be taxed in the same manner as an ordinary corporation without any deduction for its distributions to shareholders, and all distributions from the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits (including any distributions of its net tax-exempt income and net long-term capital gains) to its shareholders will be taxable to shareholders as dividend income. In addition, the Fund could be required to recognize unrealized gains, pay substantial taxes and interest and make substantial distributions before requalifying as a regulated investment company.

Excise Tax

If a Fund fails to distribute by December 31 of each calendar year at least the sum of 98% of its ordinary income for that year (excluding capital gains and losses) and 98% of its capital gain net income (adjusted for net ordinary losses) for the 1-year period ending on October 31 of that year (or November 30 or December 31 of that year if the Fund is permitted to elect and so elects), and any of its ordinary income and capital gain net income from previous years that were not distributed during such years, the Fund will be subject to a nondeductible 4% excise tax on the undistributed amounts. For these purposes, a Fund will be treated as having distributed any amount on which it has been subject to corporate income tax in the taxable year ending within the calendar year. Each Fund generally intends to actually distribute or be deemed to have distributed substantially all of its ordinary income and capital gain net income, if any, by the end of each calendar year and, thus, expects not to be subject to the excise tax. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to the excise tax. Moreover, each Fund reserves the right to pay an excise tax rather than make an additional distribution when circumstances warrant (for example, if the amount of excise tax to be paid is deemed de minimis by a Fund).

Capital Loss Carryforwards

Subject to certain limitations, a Fund is permitted to carry forward a net capital loss from any year to offset its capital gains, if any, realized during the eight years following the year of the loss. A Fund’s capital loss carryforward is treated as a short-term capital loss in the year to which it is carried. If future capital gains are offset by carried forward capital losses, such future capital gains are not subject to fund-level U.S. federal income taxation, regardless of whether they are distributed to shareholders. Accordingly, the Funds do not expect to distribute any such offsetting capital gains. The Funds cannot carry back or carry forward any net operating losses.

Equalization Accounting

Each Fund may use the so-called “equalization method” of accounting to allocate a portion of its “accumulated earnings and profits,” which generally equals a Fund’s undistributed net investment income and realized capital gains, with certain adjustments, to redemption proceeds. This method permits a Fund to achieve more balanced distributions for both continuing and redeeming shareholders. Although using this method generally will not affect a Fund’s total returns, it may reduce the amount of income and gains that the Fund would otherwise distribute to continuing shareholders by reducing the effect of redemptions of Fund shares on Fund distributions to shareholders. The IRS has not sanctioned the particular equalization method used by the Funds, and thus a Fund’s use of this method may be subject to IRS scrutiny.

 

141


Table of Contents

 

Investment through Master Portfolios

Some Funds seek to continue to qualify as regulated investment companies by investing their assets through one or more Master Portfolios. Each Master Portfolio will be treated as a non-publicly traded partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes rather than as a regulated investment company or a corporation under the Code. Under the rules applicable to a non-publicly traded partnership, a proportionate share of any interest, dividends, gains and losses of a Master Portfolio will be deemed to have been realized (i.e., “passed through”) to its investors, including the corresponding Fund, regardless of whether any amounts are actually distributed by the Master Portfolio. Each investor in a Master Portfolio will be taxed on such share, as determined in accordance with the governing instruments of the particular Master Portfolio, the Code and Treasury Regulations, in determining such investor’s U.S. federal income tax liability. Therefore, to the extent a Master Portfolio were to accrue but not distribute any income or gains, the corresponding Fund would be deemed to have realized its proportionate share of such income or gains without receipt of any corresponding distribution. However, each of the Master Portfolios will seek to minimize recognition by its investors (such as a corresponding Fund) of income and gains without a corresponding distribution. Furthermore, each Master Portfolio intends to manage its assets, income and distributions in such a way that an investor in a Master Portfolio will be able to continue to qualify as a regulated investment company by investing its assets through the Master Portfolio.

Taxation of Fund Investments

In general, realized gains or losses on the sale of securities held by a Fund will be treated as capital gains or losses, and long-term capital gains or losses if the Fund has held or is deemed to have held the securities for more than one year at the time of disposition.

If a Fund purchases a debt obligation with original issue discount (OID) (generally a debt obligation with an issue price less than its stated principal amount, such as a zero-coupon bond), the Fund may be required to annually include in its income a portion of the OID as ordinary income, even though the Fund will not receive cash payments for such discount until maturity or disposition of the obligation. Inflation-protected bonds generally can be expected to produce OID income as their principal amounts are adjusted upward for inflation. In general, gains recognized on the disposition of (or the receipt of any partial payment of principal on) a debt obligation (including a municipal obligation) purchased by a Fund at a market discount, generally at a price less than its principal amount, will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the portion of market discount which accrued, but was not previously recognized pursuant to an available election, during the term that the Fund held the debt obligation. A Fund generally will be required to make distributions to shareholders representing the OID or market discount (if an election is made by the Fund to accrue market discount over the holding period of the applicable debt obligation) on debt securities that is currently includible in income, even though the cash representing such income may not have been received by the Fund. Cash to pay such distributions may be obtained from borrowing or from sales proceeds of securities held by a Fund which the Fund otherwise might have continued to hold; obtaining such cash might be disadvantageous for the Fund.

In addition, payment-in-kind securities similarly will give rise to income which is required to be distributed and is taxable even though a Fund receives no cash interest payment on the security during the year. A portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations (such as high-yield corporate debt securities) may not (and interest paid on debt obligations owned by a Fund that are considered for tax purposes to be payable in the equity of the issuer or a related party will not) be deductible to the issuer, possibly affecting the cash flow of the issuer.

If a Fund invests in debt obligations that are in the lowest rating categories or are unrated, including debt obligations of issuers not currently paying interest or who are in default, special tax issues may exist for the Fund. Tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as whether a Fund should recognize market discount on a debt obligation and, if so, the amount of market discount the Fund should recognize, when a Fund may cease to accrue interest, OID or market discount, when and to what extent deductions may be taken for bad debts or

 

142


Table of Contents

worthless securities and how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income. These and other related issues will be addressed by a Fund when, as and if it invests in such securities, in order to seek to ensure that it distributes sufficient income to preserve its status as a regulated investment company and does not become subject to U.S. federal income or excise tax.

If an option granted by a Fund is sold, lapses or is otherwise terminated through a closing transaction, such as a repurchase by the Fund of the option from its holder, the Fund generally will realize a short-term capital gain or loss, depending on whether the premium income is greater or less than the amount paid by the Fund in the closing transaction. Some capital losses realized by a Fund in the sale, exchange, exercise or other disposition of an option may be deferred if they result from a position that is part of a “straddle,” discussed below. If securities are sold by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a covered call option granted by it, the Fund generally will add the premium received to the sale price of the securities delivered in determining the amount of gain or loss on the sale. If securities are purchased by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a put option written by it, the Fund generally will subtract the premium received from its cost basis in the securities purchased.

Some regulated futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity, listed options that may be used by a Fund will be deemed “Section 1256 contracts.” A Fund will be required to “mark to market” any such contracts held at the end of the taxable year by treating them as if they had been sold on the last day of that year at market value. Sixty percent of any net gain or loss realized on all dispositions of Section 1256 contracts, including deemed dispositions under the “mark-to-market” rule, generally will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss, and the remaining 40% will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss, although certain foreign currency gains and losses from such contracts may be treated as ordinary income or loss as described below. These provisions may require a Fund to recognize income or gains without a concurrent receipt of cash. Transactions that qualify as designated hedges are exempt from the mark-to-market rule and the “60%/40%” rule and may require the Fund to defer the recognition of losses on certain futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity options.

Foreign exchange gains and losses realized by a Fund in connection with certain transactions involving foreign currency-denominated debt securities, certain options, futures contracts, forward contracts and similar instruments relating to foreign currency, foreign currencies, or payables or receivables denominated in a foreign currency are subject to Section 988 of the Code, which generally causes such gains and losses to be treated as ordinary income or loss and may affect the amount and timing of recognition of the Fund’s income. Under future Treasury Regulations, any such transactions that are not directly related to a Fund’s investments in stock or securities (or its options contracts or futures contracts with respect to stock or securities) may have to be limited in order to enable the Fund to satisfy the 90% qualifying income test described above. If the net foreign exchange loss exceeds a Fund’s net investment company taxable income (computed without regard to such loss) for a taxable year, the resulting ordinary loss for such year will not be available as a carryforward and thus cannot be deducted by the Fund or its shareholders in future years.

Offsetting positions held by a Fund involving certain derivative instruments, such as forward, futures and options contracts, may be considered, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to constitute “straddles.” “Straddles” are defined to include “offsetting positions” in actively traded personal property. The tax treatment of “straddles” is governed by Section 1092 of the Code which, in certain circumstances, overrides or modifies the provisions of Section 1256. If a Fund is treated as entering into a “straddle” and at least one (but not all) of the Fund’s positions in derivative contracts comprising a part of such straddle is governed by Section 1256 of the Code, described above, then such straddle could be characterized as a “mixed straddle.” A Fund may make one or more elections with respect to “mixed straddles.” Depending upon which election is made, if any, the results with respect to a Fund may differ. Generally, to the extent the straddle rules apply to positions established by a Fund, losses realized by the Fund may be deferred to the extent of unrealized gain in any offsetting positions. Moreover, as a result of the straddle rules, short-term capital loss on straddle positions may be recharacterized as long-term capital loss, and long-term capital gain may be characterized as short-term capital gain. In addition, the existence of a straddle may affect the holding period of the offsetting positions. As a result, the straddle rules

 

143


Table of Contents

could cause distributions that would otherwise constitute “qualified dividend income” or qualify for the dividends-received deduction to fail to satisfy the applicable holding period requirements (as described below). Furthermore, the Fund may be required to capitalize, rather than deduct currently, any interest expense and carrying charges applicable to a position that is part of a straddle, including any interest on indebtedness incurred or continued to purchase or carry any positions that are part of a straddle. The application of the straddle rules to certain offsetting Fund positions can therefore affect the amount, timing, and character of distributions to shareholders, and may result in significant differences from the amount, timing and character of distributions that would have been made by the Fund if it had not entered into offsetting positions in respect of certain of its portfolio securities.

If a Fund enters into a “constructive sale” of any appreciated financial position in stock, a partnership interest, or certain debt instruments, the Fund will be treated as if it had sold and immediately repurchased the property and must recognize gain (but not loss) with respect to that position. A constructive sale of an appreciated financial position occurs when a Fund enters into certain offsetting transactions with respect to the same or substantially identical property, including, but not limited to: (i) a short sale; (ii) an offsetting notional principal contract; (iii) a futures or forward contract; or (iv) other transactions identified in future Treasury Regulations. The character of the gain from constructive sales will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the appreciated financial position. Losses realized from a sale of a position that was previously the subject of a constructive sale will be recognized when the position is subsequently disposed of. The character of such losses will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the position beginning with the date the constructive sale was deemed to have occurred and the application of various loss deferral provisions in the Code. Constructive sale treatment does not apply to certain closed transactions, including if such a transaction is closed on or before the 30th day after the close of the Fund’s taxable year and the Fund holds the appreciated financial position unhedged throughout the 60-day period beginning with the day such transaction was closed.

The amount of long-term capital gain a Fund may recognize from certain derivative transactions with respect to interests in certain pass-through entities is limited under the Code’s constructive ownership rules. The amount of long-term capital gain is limited to the amount of such gain the Fund would have had if the Fund directly invested in the pass-through entity during the term of the derivative contract. Any gain in excess of this amount is treated as ordinary income. An interest charge is imposed on the amount of gain that is treated as ordinary income.

If a Fund makes a distribution of income received by the Fund in lieu of dividends (a “substitute payment”) with respect to securities on loan pursuant to a securities lending transaction, such income will not constitute qualified dividend income to individual shareholders and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction for corporate shareholders. Similar consequences may apply to repurchase and other derivative transactions. Similarly, to the extent that a Fund makes distributions of income received by such Fund in lieu of tax-exempt interest with respect to securities on loan, such distributions will not constitute exempt-interest dividends (defined below) to shareholders.

In addition, a Fund’s transactions in securities and certain types of derivatives (e.g., options, futures contracts, forward contracts and swap agreements) may be subject to other special tax rules, such as the wash-sale rules or the short-sale rules, the effect of which may be to accelerate income to the Fund, defer losses to the Fund, cause adjustments in the holding periods of the Fund’s securities, convert long-term capital gains into short-term capital gains, and/or convert short-term capital losses into long-term capital losses. These rules could therefore affect the amount, timing and character of distributions to shareholders.

Certain of a Fund’s investments in derivative instruments and foreign currency-denominated instruments, as well as any of its foreign currency transactions and hedging activities, are likely to produce a difference between its book income and its taxable income. If a Fund’s book income exceeds the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the distribution (if any) of such excess generally will be treated as (i) a dividend to the extent of the Fund’s remaining earnings and profits (including earnings and profits arising from tax-exempt

 

144


Table of Contents

income), (ii) thereafter, as a return of capital to the extent of the recipient’s basis in its shares, and (iii) thereafter, as gain from the sale or exchange of a capital asset. If a Fund’s book income is less than the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the Fund could be required to make distributions exceeding book income to qualify as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment.

Rules governing the U.S. federal income tax aspects of derivatives, including swap agreements, are in a developing stage and are not entirely clear in certain respects. Accordingly, while each Fund intends to account for such transactions in a manner it deems to be appropriate, an adverse determination or future guidance by the IRS with respect to these rules (which determination or guidance could be retroactive) may affect whether a Fund has made sufficient distributions, and otherwise satisfied the relevant requirements to maintain its qualification as a regulated investment company and avoid fund-level tax. Certain requirements that must be met under the Code in order for a Fund to qualify as a regulated investment company may limit the extent to which a Fund will be able to engage in certain derivatives transactions.

Any investment by a Fund in equity securities of a REIT may result in the Fund’s receipt of cash in excess of the REIT’s earnings; if the Fund distributes these amounts, these distributions could constitute a return of capital to Fund shareholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Investments in equity securities of a REIT or another regulated investment company also may require a Fund to accrue and distribute income not yet received. To generate sufficient cash to make the requisite distributions, the Fund may be required to sell securities in its portfolio (including when it is not advantageous to do so) that it otherwise would have continued to hold. Dividends received by the Fund from a REIT generally will not constitute qualified dividend income and will not qualify for the dividends-received deduction.

A Fund may invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in taxable mortgage pools (TMPs). Under an IRS notice, and Treasury Regulations that have yet to be issued but may apply retroactively, a portion of a Fund’s income (including income allocated to the Fund from a REIT, a regulated investment company or other pass-through entity) that is attributable to a residual interest in a REMIC or an equity interest in a TMP (referred to in the Code as an “excess inclusion”) will be subject to U.S. federal income tax in all events. This notice also provides, and the regulations are expected to provide, that excess inclusion income of a regulated investment company, such as a Fund, will be allocated to shareholders of the regulated investment company in proportion to the dividends received by such shareholders, with the same consequences as if the shareholders held the related interest directly. As a result, the Fund may not be a suitable investment for certain tax-exempt shareholders, as noted under “Tax-Exempt Shareholders” below.

In general, excess inclusion income allocated to shareholders (i) cannot be offset by net operating losses (subject to a limited exception for certain thrift institutions), (ii) will constitute unrelated business taxable income (UBTI) to entities (including a qualified pension plan, an individual retirement account, a 401(k) plan, a Keogh plan or certain other tax-exempt entities) subject to tax on UBTI, thereby potentially requiring such an entity that is allocated excess inclusion income, and otherwise might not be required to file a tax return, to file a tax return and pay tax on such income, and (iii) in the case of a foreign shareholder, will not qualify for any reduction in U.S. federal withholding tax.

Some amounts received by a Fund from its investments in MLPs will likely be treated as returns of capital because of accelerated deductions available with respect to the activities of MLPs. On the disposition of an investment in such an MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of economic gain from that asset (or if a Fund does not dispose of the MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of cash flow received by the Fund from the MLP in a later period), and the Fund must take such income into account in determining whether the Fund has satisfied its regulated investment company distribution requirements. The Fund may have to borrow or liquidate securities to satisfy its distribution requirements and meet its redemption requests, even though investment considerations might otherwise make it undesirable for the Fund to borrow money or sell securities at the time. In addition, distributions attributable to gain from the sale of MLPs that are characterized as ordinary income under the Code’s recapture provisions will be taxable to Fund shareholders as ordinary income.

 

145


Table of Contents

 

“Passive foreign investment companies” (PFICs) are generally defined as foreign corporations where at least 75% of their gross income for their taxable year is income from passive sources (such as certain interest, dividends, rents and royalties, or capital gains) or at least 50% of their assets on average produce such passive income. If a Fund acquires any equity interest in a PFIC, the Fund could be subject to U.S. federal income tax and interest charges on “excess distributions” received from the PFIC or on gain from the sale of such equity interest in the PFIC, even if all income or gain actually received by the Fund is timely distributed to its shareholders. Excess distributions and gain from the sale of interests in PFICs may be characterized as ordinary income even though, absent the application of PFIC rules, these amounts may otherwise have been classified as capital gain.

A Fund will not be permitted to pass through to its shareholders any credit or deduction for these special taxes and interest charges incurred with respect to a PFIC. Elections may be available that would ameliorate these adverse tax consequences, but such elections would require a Fund to include its share of the PFIC’s income and net capital gains annually, regardless of whether it receives any distribution from the PFIC (in the case of a “QEF election”), or to mark the gains (and to a limited extent losses) in its interests in the PFIC “to the market” as though the Fund had sold and repurchased such interests on the last day of the Fund’s taxable year, treating such gains and losses as ordinary income and loss (in the case of a “mark-to-market election”). The QEF and mark-to-market elections may require a Fund to recognize taxable income or gain without the concurrent receipt of cash and increase the amount required to be distributed by the Fund to avoid taxation. Making either of these elections therefore may require a Fund to liquidate other investments prematurely to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above, which also may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return. Each Fund may attempt to limit and/or manage its holdings in PFICs to minimize tax liability and/or maximize returns from these investments but there can be no assurance that it will be able to do so. Moreover, because it is not always possible to identify a foreign corporation as a PFIC in advance of acquiring shares in the corporation, a Fund may incur the tax and interest charges described above in some instances. Dividends paid by PFICs will not be eligible to be treated as qualified dividend income, as defined below.

In addition to the investments described above, prospective shareholders should be aware that other investments made by a Fund may involve complex tax rules that may result in income or gain recognition by the Fund without corresponding current cash receipts. Although each Fund seeks to avoid significant noncash income, such noncash income could be recognized by a Fund, in which case the Fund may distribute cash derived from other sources in order to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above. In this regard, a Fund could be required at times to liquidate investments prematurely in order to satisfy its minimum distribution requirements, which may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return.

Taxation of Distributions

Except for exempt-interest dividends (defined below) paid by a Fund, distributions paid out of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits, whether paid in cash or reinvested in the Fund, generally are deemed to be taxable distributions and must be reported by each shareholder who is required to file a U.S. federal income tax return. Dividends and distributions on a Fund’s shares are generally subject to U.S. federal income tax as described herein to the extent they do not exceed the Fund’s realized income and gains, even though such dividends and distributions may economically represent a return of a particular shareholder’s investment. Such distributions are likely to occur in respect of shares purchased at a time when the Fund’s net asset value reflects either unrealized gains, or realized but undistributed income or gains. Such realized income and gains may be required to be distributed even when the Fund’s net asset value also reflects unrealized losses. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, a Fund’s earnings and profits, described above, are determined at the end of the Fund’s taxable year and are allocated pro rata to distributions paid over the entire year. Distributions in excess of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits will first be treated as a return of capital up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares and then as capital gain. A return of capital is not taxable, but

 

146


Table of Contents

it reduces a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares, thus reducing any loss or increasing any gain on a subsequent taxable disposition by the shareholder of his or her shares. A Fund may make distributions in excess of its earnings and profits to a limited extent, from time to time.

For U.S. federal income tax purposes, distributions of investment income (except for exempt-interest dividends, defined below) are generally taxable as ordinary income, and distributions of gains from the sale of investments that a Fund owned (or is deemed to have owned) for one year or less will be taxable as ordinary income. Distributions properly designated by a Fund as capital gain dividends (“Capital Gain Dividends”) will be taxable to shareholders as long-term capital gain (to the extent such distributions do not exceed the Fund’s actual net long-term capital gain for the taxable year), regardless of how long a shareholder has held Fund shares, and do not qualify as dividends for purposes of the dividends-received deduction or as qualified dividend income (defined below). Each Fund will designate Capital Gain Dividends, if any, in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year.

Some states will not tax distributions made to individual shareholders that are attributable to interest a Fund earns on direct obligations of the U.S. government if the Fund meets the state’s minimum investment or reporting requirements, if any. Investments in GNMA or FNMA securities, bankers’ acceptances, commercial paper, and repurchase agreements collateralized by U.S. government securities generally do not qualify for tax-free treatment. This exemption may not apply to corporate shareholders.

Sales and Exchanges of Fund Shares

If a shareholder sells or exchanges his or her Fund shares, he or she generally will realize a taxable capital gain or loss on the difference between the amount received for the shares (or deemed received in the case of an exchange) and his or her tax basis in the shares. This gain or loss will be long-term capital gain or loss if he or she has held (or is deemed to have held) such Fund shares for more than one year at the time of the sale or exchange, and short-term capital gain or loss otherwise.

If a shareholder sells or exchanges Fund shares within 90 days of having acquired such shares and if, as a result of having initially acquired those shares, he or she subsequently pays a reduced sales charge on a new purchase of shares of the Fund or a different regulated investment company, the sales charge previously incurred in acquiring the Fund’s shares generally shall not be taken into account (to the extent the previous sales charges do not exceed the reduction in sales charges on the new purchase) for the purpose of determining the amount of gain or loss on the disposition, but generally will be treated as having been incurred in the new purchase. Also, if a shareholder realizes a loss on a disposition of Fund shares, the loss will be disallowed under “wash sale” rules to the extent that he or she purchases substantially identical shares within the 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the disposition. Any disallowed loss generally will be reflected in an adjustment to the tax basis of the purchased shares.

If a shareholder receives a Capital Gain Dividend or is deemed to receive a distribution of long-term capital gain with respect to any Fund share and such Fund share is held or treated as held for six months or less, then (unless otherwise disallowed) any loss on the sale or exchange of that Fund share will be treated as a long-term capital loss to the extent of the Capital Gain Dividend or deemed long-term capital gain distribution. If shares of a Fund are sold at a loss after being held for six months or less, the loss will be disallowed to the extent of any exempt-interest dividends (defined below) received on those shares.

Foreign Taxes

Amounts realized by a Fund from sources within foreign countries may be subject to withholding and other taxes imposed by such countries. Tax conventions between certain countries and the United States may reduce or eliminate such taxes. If more than 50% of the value of a Fund’s total assets at the close of its taxable year consists of securities of foreign corporations, the Fund will be eligible to file an annual election with the IRS

 

147


Table of Contents

pursuant to which the Fund may pass through to its shareholders on a pro rata basis foreign income and similar taxes paid by the Fund with respect to foreign securities that the Fund has held for at least the minimum holding periods specified in the Code and such taxes may be claimed, subject to certain limitations, either as a tax credit or deduction by the shareholders. A Fund that invests primarily or exclusively in other regulated investment companies would not be eligible for this election, even if the underlying regulated investment companies were eligible and did make the election.

Certain Funds may qualify for and make the election; however, even if a Fund qualifies for the election for any year, it may determine not to make the election for such year. If a Fund does not so qualify or qualifies but does not so elect, then shareholders will not be entitled to claim a credit or deduction with respect to foreign taxes paid by or withheld from payments to the Fund. A Fund will notify its shareholders within 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year if it has elected for the foreign taxes paid by it to “pass through” for that year.

In general, if a Fund makes the election, the Fund itself will not be permitted to claim a credit or deduction for foreign taxes paid in that year, and the Fund’s dividends-paid deduction will be increased by the amount of foreign taxes paid that year. Fund shareholders generally shall include their proportionate share of the foreign taxes paid by the Fund in their gross income and treat that amount as paid by them for the purpose of the foreign tax credit or deduction, provided that any applicable holding period and other requirements have been met. If a shareholder claims a credit for foreign taxes paid, in general, the credit will be subject to certain limits. A deduction for foreign taxes paid may be claimed only by shareholders that itemize their deductions.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Rates

As of the date of this SAI, the maximum stated U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to individuals generally is 35% for ordinary income and 15% for net long-term capital gain. Long-term capital gain rates applicable to individuals have been temporarily reduced – in general, to 15% with lower rates applying to taxpayers in the 10% and 15% rate brackets – for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

For taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011, U.S. federal income tax law also provides for a maximum individual U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to “qualified dividend income” equal to the highest net long-term capital gain rate, which, as described above, generally is 15%. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011. In general, “qualified dividend income” is income attributable to dividends received by a Fund from certain domestic and foreign corporations, as long as certain holding period and other requirements are met by the Fund with respect to the dividend-paying corporation’s stock and by the shareholders with respect to the Fund’s shares. If 95% or more of a Fund’s gross income (excluding net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) constitutes qualified dividend income, all of its distributions (other than Capital Gain Dividends) will be generally treated as qualified dividend income in the hands of individual shareholders, as long as they have owned their Fund shares for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the Fund’s ex-dividend date (or, in the case of certain preferred stock, 91 days during the 181-day period beginning 90 days before such date) and meet certain other requirements specified in the Code. In general, if less than 95% of a Fund’s income is attributable to qualified dividend income, then only the portion of the Fund’s distributions that is attributable to qualified dividend income and designated as such in a timely manner will be so treated in the hands of individual shareholders who meet the aforementioned holding period requirements. The rules regarding the qualification of Fund distributions as qualified dividend income are complex, including the holding period requirements. Individual Fund shareholders therefore are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners. Fixed income funds typically do not distribute significant amounts of qualified dividend income.

The maximum stated corporate U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to ordinary income and net capital gain is 35%. Actual marginal tax rates may be higher for some shareholders, for example, through reductions in deductions. Naturally, the amount of tax payable by any taxpayer will be affected by a combination of tax laws

 

148


Table of Contents

covering, for example, deductions, credits, deferrals, exemptions, sources of income and other matters. U.S. federal income tax rates are set to increase in future years under various “sunset” provisions of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Backup Withholding

Each Fund generally is required to withhold, and remit to the U.S. Treasury, subject to certain exemptions, an amount equal to 28% of all distributions and redemption proceeds (including proceeds from exchanges and redemptions in-kind) paid or credited to a Fund shareholder if (1) the shareholder fails to furnish the Fund with a correct “taxpayer identification number” (TIN) or has not certified to the Fund that withholding does not apply or (2) the IRS notifies the Fund that the shareholder’s TIN is incorrect or the shareholder is otherwise subject to backup withholding. These backup withholding rules may also apply to distributions that are properly designated as exempt-interest dividends (defined below). This backup withholding is not an additional tax imposed on the shareholder. The shareholder may apply amounts required to be withheld as a credit against his or her future U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS. If a shareholder fails to furnish a valid TIN upon request, the shareholder can also be subject to IRS penalties. Unless Congress enacts legislation providing otherwise, the rate of backup withholding is set to increase to 31% for amounts distributed or paid after December 31, 2010.

Tax-Deferred Plans

The shares of a Fund may be available for a variety of tax-deferred retirement and other tax-advantaged plans and accounts. Prospective investors should contact their tax advisors and financial planners regarding the tax consequences to them of holding Fund shares through such plans and/or accounts.

Corporate Shareholders

Subject to limitations and other rules, a corporate shareholder of a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction on Fund distributions attributable to dividends received by the Fund from domestic corporations, which, if received directly by the corporate shareholder, would qualify for such a deduction. For eligible corporate shareholders, the dividends-received deduction may be subject to certain reductions, and a distribution by a Fund attributable to dividends of a domestic corporation will be eligible for the deduction only if certain holding period and other requirements are met. These requirements are complex; therefore, corporate shareholders of the Funds are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners.

As discussed above, a portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations that a Fund may own may not be deductible to the issuer. If a portion of the interest paid or accrued on these obligations is not deductible, that portion will be treated as a dividend. In such cases, if the issuer of the obligation is a domestic corporation, dividend payments by a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction to the extent of the dividend portion of such interest.

Foreign Shareholders

For purposes of this discussion, “foreign shareholders” generally include: (i) nonresident alien individuals, (ii) foreign trusts (i.e., a trust other than a trust with respect to which a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over administration of that trust and one or more U.S. persons have authority to control substantial decisions of that trust), (iii) foreign estates (i.e., the income of which is not subject to U.S. tax regardless of source), and (iv) foreign corporations.

Generally, unless an exception applies, dividend distributions made to foreign shareholders other than Capital Gain Dividends and exempt-interest dividends (defined below) will be subject to non-refundable U.S. federal income tax withholding at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income

 

149


Table of Contents

tax treaty) even if they are funded by income or gains (such as portfolio interest, short-term capital gains, or foreign-source dividend and interest income) that, if paid to a foreign person directly, would not be subject to withholding. However, generally, for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions made to foreign shareholders and properly designated by a Fund as “interest-related dividends” were exempt from U.S. federal income tax withholding. The exemption for interest-related dividends did not apply to any distribution to a foreign shareholder (i) to the extent that the dividend was attributable to certain interest on an obligation if the foreign shareholder was the issuer or was a 10% shareholder of the issuer, (ii) that was within certain foreign countries that had inadequate information exchange with the United States, or (iii) to the extent the dividend was attributable to interest paid by a person that was a related person of the foreign shareholder and the foreign shareholder was a controlled foreign corporation. Interest-related dividends were generally attributable to the Fund’s net U.S.-source interest income of types similar to those not subject to U.S. federal income tax if earned directly by an individual foreign shareholder. In order to qualify as an interest-related dividend, the Fund was required to designate a distribution as such in a written notice mailed to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a distribution described above is “effectively connected” with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, is attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the recipient foreign shareholder, U.S. federal income tax withholding will not apply. Instead, the distribution will be subject to the tax, reporting and withholding requirements generally applicable to U.S. persons, and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the recipient foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation.

In general, a foreign shareholder’s capital gains realized on the disposition of Fund shares and distributions properly designated as Capital Gain Dividends are not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax, unless: (i) such gains or distributions are effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, are attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the foreign shareholder; (ii) in the case of an individual foreign shareholder, the shareholder is present in the U.S. for a period or periods aggregating 183 days or more during the year of the disposition of Fund shares or the receipt of Capital Gain Dividends and certain other conditions are met; or (iii) the Fund shares on which the foreign shareholder realized gain constitute U.S. real property interests (USRPIs, defined below) or, in certain cases, the distributions are attributable to gain from the sale or exchange of a USRPI, as discussed below. If the requirements of clause (i) are met, the tax, reporting and withholding requirements applicable to U.S. persons generally will apply to the foreign shareholder and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation. If the requirements of clause (i) are not met, but the requirements of clause (ii) are met, such gains and distributions will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income tax treaty). Please see below for a discussion of the tax implications to foreign shareholders in the event that clause (iii) applies. With respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions to a foreign shareholder attributable to a Fund’s net short-term capital gain in excess of its net long-term capital loss and designated as such by the Fund in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year (“short-term capital gain dividends”) were generally not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax unless clause (i), (ii) or (iii) above applied to such distribution.

It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend the exemptions from withholding for interest-related dividends and short-term capital gain dividends with respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Even if permitted to do so, each Fund provides no assurance that it would designate any distributions as interest-related dividends or short-term capital gain dividends.

In the case of shares held through an intermediary, even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment, no assurance can be made that the intermediary will respect such a designation, and an intermediary may withhold even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment. Foreign shareholders should contact their intermediaries regarding the application of these rules to their accounts.

Special rules apply to distributions to foreign shareholders from a Fund if it is either a “U.S. real property holding corporation” (USRPHC) or would be a USRPHC but for the operation of certain exceptions from USRPI

 

150


Table of Contents

treatment for interests in domestically controlled REITs or regulated investment companies and not-greater- than-5% interests in publicly traded classes of stock in REITs or regulated investment companies. Additionally, special rules apply to the sale of shares in a Fund if it is a USRPHC. Generally, a USRPHC is a domestic corporation that holds USRPIs – defined generally as any interest in U.S. real property or any equity interest in a USRPHC – the fair market value of which equals or exceeds 50% of the sum of the fair market values of the corporation’s USRPIs, interests in real property located outside the United States and other assets. If a Fund holds (directly or indirectly) significant interests in REITs, it may be a USRPHC.

If a Fund is a USRPHC or would be a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, amounts the Fund receives from REITs derived from gains realized from USRPIs generally will retain their character as such in the hands of the Fund’s foreign shareholders. In the hands of a foreign shareholder that holds (or has held in the prior 12 months) more than a 5% interest in any class of the Fund, such amounts generally will be treated as gains “effectively connected” with the conduct of a “U.S. trade or business,” and subject to tax at graduated rates. Moreover, such shareholder generally will be required to file a U.S. income tax return for the year recognized, and the Fund must withhold 35% of the amount of such distribution. Otherwise, in the case of all other foreign shareholders (i.e., those whose interest in any class of the Fund did not exceed 5% at any time during the prior 12 months), such amounts generally will be treated as ordinary income (regardless of any designation by the Fund that such distribution is a Capital Gain Dividend), and the Fund must withhold 30% (or a lower applicable treaty rate) of the amount of the distribution paid to such shareholders. If a Fund is subject to the rules of this paragraph, its foreign shareholders may also be subject to “wash sale” rules to prevent the avoidance of the foregoing tax-filing and payment obligations through the sale and repurchase of Fund shares. Prior to January 1, 2010, if a Fund was a USRPHC or would have been a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, similar rules generally also applied to any non-REIT USRPI gains recognized by the Fund directly or indirectly through certain lower-tier regulated investment companies. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend such application for distributions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be.

In addition, if a Fund is a USRPHC, it generally must withhold 10% of the amount realized in redemption by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder, and that shareholder must file a U.S. income tax return for the year of the disposition of the USRPI and pay any additional tax due on the gain. Prior to January 1, 2010, such withholding generally was not required with respect to amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund if it was a domestically controlled USRPHC, or, in certain limited cases, if the Fund (whether or not domestically controlled) held substantial investments in regulated investment companies that were domestically controlled USRPHCs. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this exemption from withholding for redemptions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Unless and until such legislation is enacted, beginning on January 1, 2010, withholding is required in respect of amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder if the Fund is a USRPHC, without regard to whether the Fund or any regulated investment company in which it invests is domestically controlled.

In order to qualify for any exemptions from withholding described above or for lower withholding tax rates under income tax treaties, or to establish an exemption from backup withholding, a foreign shareholder must comply with applicable certification requirements relating to its foreign status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN or substitute form). Foreign shareholders should consult their tax advisors in this regard.

Special rules (including withholding and reporting requirements) apply to foreign partnerships and those holding Fund shares through foreign partnerships. In addition, additional considerations may apply to foreign trusts and foreign estates. Investors holding Fund shares through foreign entities should consult their tax advisors about their particular situation.

If a Fund qualifies and makes an election to pass through foreign taxes to its shareholders, as described earlier, foreign shareholders of the Fund generally will be subject to increased U.S. federal income taxation without a corresponding benefit for the pass-through of foreign taxes.

 

151


Table of Contents

 

A beneficial holder of shares who is a foreign person may be subject to state and local tax and to the U.S. federal estate tax in addition to the U.S. federal income tax referred to above.

Tax-Exempt Shareholders

Under current law, a Fund serves to “block” (that is, prevent the attribution to shareholders of) UBTI from being realized by tax-exempt shareholders. Notwithstanding this “blocking” effect, a tax-exempt shareholder could realize UBTI by virtue of its investment in a Fund if shares in the Fund constitute debt-financed property in the hands of the tax-exempt shareholder within the meaning of Code Section 514(b).

It is possible that a tax-exempt shareholder will also recognize UBTI if a Fund recognizes excess inclusion income (as described above) derived from direct or indirect investments in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Furthermore, any investment in residual interests of a CMO that has elected to be treated as a REMIC can create complex tax consequences, especially if the Fund has state or local governments or other tax-exempt organizations as shareholders.

In addition, special tax consequences apply to charitable remainder trusts (CRTs) that invest in regulated investment companies that invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Under legislation enacted in December 2006, a CRT, as defined in Section 664 of the Code, that realizes UBTI for a taxable year must pay an excise tax annually of an amount equal to such UBTI. Under IRS guidance issued in October 2006, a CRT will not recognize UBTI solely as a result of investing in a Fund to the extent that it recognizes excess inclusion income. Rather, if at any time during any taxable year a CRT (or one of certain other tax-exempt shareholders, such as the United States, a state or political subdivision, or an agency or instrumentality thereof, and certain energy cooperatives) is a record holder of a share in a Fund and the Fund recognizes excess inclusion income, then the Fund will be subject to a tax on that portion of its excess inclusion income for the taxable year that is allocable to such shareholders at the highest U.S. federal corporate income tax rate. The extent to which the IRS guidance remains applicable in light of the December 2006 legislation is unclear. To the extent permitted under the 1940 Act, each Fund may elect to specially allocate any such tax to the applicable CRT, or other shareholder, and thus reduce such shareholder’s distributions for the year by the amount of the tax that relates to such shareholder’s interest in the Fund. Each Fund has not yet determined whether such an election will be made. CRTs are urged to consult their tax advisors concerning the consequences of investing in a Fund.

Shareholder Reporting Requirements Regarding Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts and Other Foreign Financial Assets

Effective for taxable years beginning after March 18, 2010, certain individuals (and, if provided in future guidance, certain domestic entities) must disclose annually their interests in “specified foreign financial assets” on their U.S. federal income tax returns. It is currently unclear under what circumstances, if any, a shareholder’s (indirect) interest in a Fund’s “specified foreign financial assets,” if any, falls within this requirement. In addition, shareholders that are U.S. persons and own, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of a Fund by vote or value could be required to report annually their “financial interest” in the Fund’s “foreign financial accounts,” if any, on Treasury Department Form TD F 90-22.1, Report of Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts (“FBAR”). Shareholders should consult a tax advisor regarding the applicability to them of both of these reporting requirements.

Other Reporting and Withholding Requirements

New rules enacted in March 2010 require the reporting to the IRS of direct and indirect ownership of foreign financial accounts and foreign entities by U.S. persons. Failure, including by a U.S. person, to provide this required information can result in a 30% withholding tax on certain payments (“withholdable payments”) made after December 31, 2012. Withholdable payments include U.S.-source dividends and interest, and gross proceeds from the sale or other disposal of property that can produce U.S.-source dividends or interest.

 

152


Table of Contents

 

The IRS has issued only limited guidance with respect to these new rules; their scope remains unclear and potentially subject to material change. Very generally, it appears that any distribution made by a Fund after December 31, 2012 (or such later date as may be provided in future guidance) to a shareholder, including a distribution in redemption of shares and a distribution of income or gains otherwise exempt from withholding under the rules applicable to non-U.S. shareholders described above (e.g., Capital Gain Dividends), will be subject to the new 30% withholding requirement. Payments to a foreign shareholder that is a “foreign financial institution” will generally be subject to withholding, unless such shareholder enters into an agreement with the IRS. Payments to shareholders that are U.S. persons or foreign individuals will generally not be subject to withholding, so long as such shareholders provide a Fund with such certifications or other documentation as the Fund requires to comply with the new rules. Persons investing in a Fund through an intermediary should contact their intermediary regarding the application of the new reporting and withholding regime to their investments in the Fund.

Shareholders are urged to consult a tax advisor regarding this new reporting and withholding regime, in light of their particular circumstances.

Tax Shelter Reporting Regulations

Under Treasury Regulations, if a shareholder recognizes a loss of $2 million or more for an individual shareholder or $10 million or more for a corporate shareholder, the shareholder must file with the IRS a disclosure statement on Form 8886. Direct shareholders of portfolio securities are in many cases excepted from this reporting requirement, but under current guidance, shareholders of a regulated investment company are not excepted. Future guidance may extend the current exception from this reporting requirement to shareholders of most or all regulated investment companies. The fact that a loss is reportable under these regulations does not affect the legal determination of whether the taxpayer’s treatment of the loss is proper. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors to determine the applicability of these regulations in light of their individual circumstances.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to Tax-Exempt Funds

If, at the close of each quarter of a regulated investment company’s taxable year, at least 50% of the value of its total assets consists of obligations the interest on which is exempt from U.S. federal income tax under Section 103(a) of the Code, then the regulated investment company may qualify to pay “exempt-interest dividends” and pass through to its shareholders the tax-exempt character of its income from such obligations. Certain of the Funds intend to so qualify and are designed to provide shareholders with a high level of income in the form of exempt-interest dividends, which are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax (such qualifying Funds, “the Tax-Exempt Funds”).

Distributions of capital gains or income not attributable to interest on Tax-Exempt Funds’ tax-exempt obligations will not constitute exempt-interest dividends and will be taxable to shareholders as described earlier.

Not later than 60 days after the close of a Tax-Exempt Fund’s taxable year, the Tax-Exempt Fund will notify its shareholders of the portion of the distributions for the taxable year which constitutes exempt-interest dividends. In general, if an amount of the Tax-Exempt Fund’s distribution designated as an exempt-interest dividend exceeds the fund’s net-exempt interest, the amount so qualifying as tax-exempt will be scaled back ratably to the amount of its net-exempt income. In such a case, each Tax-Exempt Fund shareholder must proportionately reduce the amount of the dividend it treats as tax-exempt, and will generally include the excess income as a taxable dividend to the extent of certain disallowed deductions and thereafter as a return of capital. The deductibility of interest paid or accrued on indebtedness incurred by a shareholder to purchase or carry shares of a Tax-Exempt Fund may be limited. The portion of such interest that is non-deductible generally equals the amount of such interest times the ratio of a Tax-Exempt Fund’s exempt-interest dividends received by the shareholder to all of the Tax-Exempt Fund’s dividends received by the shareholder (excluding Capital Gain Dividends and any capital gains required to be included in the shareholder’s long term capital gains in respect of capital gains retained by the Tax-Exempt Fund, as described earlier).

 

153


Table of Contents

 

Although exempt-interest dividends are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax, there may not be a similar exemption under the laws of a particular state or local taxing jurisdiction. Thus, exempt-interest dividends may be subject to state and local taxes; however, eaxh state-specific Tax-Exempt Funds generally invests at least 80% of its net assets in municipal bonds that pay interest that is exempt not only from U.S. federal income tax, but also from the applicable state’s personal income tax (but not necessarily local taxes or taxes of other states). You should consult your tax advisor to discuss the tax consequences of your investment in a Tax-Exempt Fund.

Tax-exempt interest on certain “private activity bonds” has been designated as a “tax preference item” and must be added back to taxable income for purposes of calculating U.S. federal alternative minimum tax (“AMT”). To the extent that a Tax-Exempt Fund invests in certain private activity bonds, its shareholders will be required to report that portion of a Tax-Exempt Fund’s distributions attributable to income from the bonds as a tax preference item in determining their U.S. federal AMT, if any. Shareholders will be notified of the tax status of distributions made by a Tax-Exempt Fund. Persons who may be “substantial users” (or “related persons” of substantial users) of facilities financed by private activity bonds should consult their tax advisors before purchasing shares in a Tax-Exempt Fund. In addition, exempt-interest dividends paid by a Tax-Exempt Fund to a corporate shareholder are, with very limited exceptions, included in the shareholder’s “adjusted current earnings” as part of its U.S. federal AMT calculation. As of the date of this SAI, individuals are subject to the U.S. federal AMT at a maximum rate of 28% and corporations at a maximum rate of 20%. Shareholders with questions or concerns about the U.S. federal AMT should consult their own tax advisors.

Ordinarily, a Tax-Exempt Fund relies on an opinion from the issuer’s bond counsel that interest on the issuer’s obligation will be exempt from U.S. federal income taxation. However, no assurance can be given that the IRS will not successfully challenge such exemption, which could cause interest on the obligation to be taxable and could jeopardize a Tax-Exempt Fund’s ability to pay exempt-interest dividends. Similar challenges may occur as to state-specific exemptions. Also, from time to time legislation may be introduced or litigation may arise that would change the treatment of exempt-interest dividends. Such litigation or legislation may have the effect of raising the state or other taxes payable by shareholders on such dividends. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors for the current law on exempt-interest dividends.

A shareholder who receives Social Security or railroad retirement benefits should consult his or her tax advisor to determine what effect, if any, an investment in a Tax-Exempt Fund may have on the federal taxation of such benefits. Exempt-interest dividends are included in income for purposes of determining the amount of benefits that are taxable.

 

154


Table of Contents

 

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

As of September 30, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “principal holder” (i.e., owns of record or is known by the Trust to own beneficially 5% or more of any class of a Fund’s outstanding shares) is listed below.

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Bond Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     231,713.9370         13.88%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     128,858.1120         7.72%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     16,991.9580         6.48%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class C

  

WELLS FARGO INVESTMENTS LLC

625 MARQUETTE AVE FL 13

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55402-2323

     13,245.4760         5.05%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     261.0300         100.00%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     261.2970         100.00%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,792,527.4810         99.93%   

 

155


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     44,395,590.7660         61.41%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     4,737,302.7060         6.55%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     620,044.1290         7.11%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     641,588.8450         7.36%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     128,497.3820         22.27%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     234,458.5820         20.29%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     254.1810         100.00%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     254.1750         100.00%   

 

156


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     22,719,786.0950         59.54%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     5,023,009.6700         13.16%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     147,904.2740         22.96%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     43,259.0470         27.49%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     10,035.0910         6.38%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class C

  

NFS LLC FEBO

FMT CO CUST R/O IRA

FBO ERIC K LIEW

3419 CROSS CREEK CIR

WOOSTER OH 44691-1863

     8,216.2920         5.22%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     213.4930         100.00%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     213.6750         100.00%   

 

157


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     213.6750         100.00%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     10,150,197.9010         31.06%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     8,889,579.8000         27.20%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     2,144,861.4930         6.56%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

SMALL GRAT LLC

35 EAGLE DR

SHARON MA 02067-2907

     2,112,423.0010         6.46%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     2,015,460.5900         6.17%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     214,418.7330         8.63%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     159,151.2010         6.41%   

 

158


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     138,725.2940         15.93%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     132.8370         100.00%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     133.2620         100.00%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     6,155,878.0700         19.19%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     6,140,791.7260         19.14%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     2,048,545.0140         6.39%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

TD AMERITRADE INC FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF OUR CLIENTS

P.O. BOX 2226

OMAHA NE 68103-2226

     1,649,852.0080         5.14%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

     1,635,431.9370         5.10%   

 

159


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

TRANSAMERICA LIFE INS COMPANY

1150 S OLIVE ST STE 2700

LOS ANGELES CA 90015-2211

     3,523,035.6830         18.82%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     654,794.7180         29.59%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     839,859.8690         23.36%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     456,912.3270         12.71%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     187,152.6570         5.21%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     271.5510         100.00%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

REGGIO REGISTER CO INC 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     42,853.8020         18.90%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     37,728.4780         16.64%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST COMPANY CUST, FBO

GREGORY PHILLIES, MD, PC

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

     18,019.8790         7.95%   

 

160


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

THOMAS J KING JR D D S PC P

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     14,940.0210         6.59%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

RAYMOND JAMES & ASSOC INC

FBO THOMAS C DAVIS & STEVEN J DAVIS TTEE

SB DAVIS COMPANY PSP

2695 ELMRIDGE DR NW

GRAND RAPIDS MI 49534-1302

     14,292.6100         6.31%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

AUBURN MANUFACTORING INC RETIREMENT

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     14,250.9170         6.29%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

ALERT AMBULANCE SERVICE INC 401K

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

     13,146.7720         5.80%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     271.5410         100.00%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     108,767,489.3180         50.20%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     14,809,519.3880         6.83%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

BOOK ENTRY ACCOUNT

ATTN: MATT MAESRI

MUTUAL FUNDS DEPT

333 W 34TH ST 7TH FL

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     12,546,091.5630         5.79%   

 

161


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT ADVISORS INC

FBO COL MODERATE GROWTH NY 529

ATTN: JIM MARIN

245 SUMMER ST FL 3

BOSTON MA 02210-1133

     11,200,007.2990         5.17%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

     55,928.8560         43.67%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class A

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

     10,252.7010         8.01%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

     6,500.1570         5.08%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     2,677.2470         44.60%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

2801 MARKET ST

SAINT LOUIS MO 63103-2523

     1,899.6370         31.64%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

LPL FINANCIAL SERVICES

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

     733.6400         12.22%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

BETTY JEAN GHOSH TR

BETTY JEAN GHOSH TTEE

245 KUIKAHI ST

HILO HI 96720-2223

     518.4120         8.64%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     316.8570         100.00%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,454,249.1510         31.17%   

 

162


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     1,059,953.6000         22.72%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     689,282.3110         14.77%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     448,523.2660         9.61%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     55,033.4560         18.55%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     53,383.4870         17.99%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

BARCLAYS CAPITAL INC.

70 HUDSON STREET, 7TH FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07302-4585

     40,192.9260         13.55%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     39,009.9630         13.15%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     222.6180         100.00%   

 

163


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

WILMINGTON TRUST RISC CUST FBO

WATTEREDGE INC EMPLOYEE SP

P.O. BOX 52129

PHOENIX AZ 85072-2129

     32,236.3850         25.92%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

NETWORK ADJUSTERS INC 401

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     20,152.4090         16.20%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

CROSE & LEMKE CONSTRUCTION INC P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     16,854.7500         13.55%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

WILMINGTON TRUST RISC CUST FBO

INDUSTRIAL ENERGY

P.O. BOX 52129

PHOENIX AZ 85072-2129

     16,817.0710         13.52%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

ORCHARD TRUST CO LLC CUST

OPP FUNDS RECORDK PRO RET PL

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VILLAGE CO 80111

     14,565.8440         11.71%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

REGGIO REGISTER CO INC 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     11,303.0530         9.09%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

JACKSIN SERVICES INC 401K RETIR

PO BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     8,346.9230         6.71%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     224.0140         100.00%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     174,231,681.5130         84.37%   

 

164


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     14,103,428.4260         6.83%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,061,274.4000         25.34%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT SERVICES LLC FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

100 MULBERRY ST

NEWARK NJ 07102-4056

     214,763.4460         5.13%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     131,479.8590         28.71%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     155,004.3560         9.81%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     131,912.6590         8.35%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.6280         100.00%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     7,739,343.1240         30.12%   

 

165


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,658,883.9410         14.24%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     220,043.2390         15.07%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     118,452.3790         8.11%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     57.5110         100.00%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

DCGT AS TTEE AND/OR CUST

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED PRIN ADVTG OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH STREET

DES MOINES IA 50392-0001

     349,799.6330         26.16%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

DCGT AS TTEE AND/OR CUST

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED PRIN ADVTG OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH STREET

DES MOINES IA 50392-0001

     258,023.3540         19.30%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK CUST

FBO HUTAMAKI LONG TERM SAVINGS & INVESTMENT PLAN

C/O JPMORGAN RPS 5500 TEAM

9300 WARD PKWY

KANSAS CITY MO 64114-3317

     198,346.9220         14.84%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK CUST

FBO HUTAMAKI LONG TERM SAVINGS & INVESTMENT PLAN

C/O JPMORGAN RPS 5500 TEAM

9300 WARD PKWY

KANSAS CITY MO 64114-3317

     74,367.5070         5.56%   

 

166


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     57.4840         100.00%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     36,097,426.4100         27.49%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     20,424,748.5680         15.56%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     17,260,116.2440         13.15%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

JOHN HANCOCK LIFE INSURANCE CO USA

RPS SEG FUNDS & ACCOUNTING ET-7

601 CONGRESS ST

BOSTON MA 02210-2804

     7,670,245.0440         5.84%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending May 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     6,720,428.1240         13.90%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     4,206,538.9500         8.70%   

 

167


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     457,352.7670         13.33%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     336,888.5590         9.82%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     469,379.8150         14.22%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     170,452.1540         5.16%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     21,778,115.1400         76.46%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

PO BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

     18,954.6860         17.89%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     13,295.4930         12.55%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     6,491.0000         16.54%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class C

  

AMERICAN ENTERPRISE INVESTMENT SVCS

PO BOX 9446

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55440-9446

     2,824.4790         7.20%   

 

168


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     220.4590         100.00%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     820,950.2480         59.81%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class Z

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     516,099.7760         37.60%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     17,139,026.3850         10.32%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,512,579.0500         25.43%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     9,631,716.6250         29.10%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     1,863,775.5590         5.63%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     405.8440         100.00%   

 

169


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     405.8440         100.00%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     83,245,905.4230         71.01%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     9,992,474.6940         8.52%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     6,348,121.9690         5.42%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending June 30:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     2,898,947.8830         35.14

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     518,408.6020         6.28

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     205,867.2160         36.48

 

170


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     323,169.4900         32.44

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class C

  

LPL FINANCIAL SERVICES

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

     54,017.2680         5.42

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     57,791,398.9660         81.53

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY LLC TTEE

FBO EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD #2T2

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     863,978.5170         5.32

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     857,698.9710         5.28

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class A

  

DCGT AS TTEE AND/OR CUST

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED FIA OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH ST

DES MOINES IA 50392-001

     847,944.5300         5.22

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     63,970.2730         9.40

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     330,773.3610         21.60

 

171


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     89,658.9020         5.85%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     87,817.7670         5.73%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     61.8810         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     65.0530         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     28,342.1690         98.89%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     5,171,440.5480         24.27%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     2,437,484.6220         11.44%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,297,671.7490         6.09%   

 

172


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     1,285,600.5530         6.03

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending August 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class A

  

TAYNIK & CO

C/O INVESTORS BANK & TRUST CO

200 CLARENDON ST #FPG90

BOSTON MA 02116-5021

     282,965.6610         9.37

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     163,972.1100         5.43

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class A

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     155,186.3500         5.14

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     65,840.3590         23.03

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class B

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     18,691.0110         6.54

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     182,062.5900         16.33

 

173


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     160,656.5000         14.41%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     127,157.7540         11.41%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     101.5430         100.00%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,380,710.7190         15.37%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     546,028.1750         6.08%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

REGIONS BANK DBA KENNEBURT CO

250 RIVERCHASE PKWY E FL 5

BIRMINGHAM AL 35244-1832

     488,272.9300         5.44%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     746,691.5880         23.21%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     90,385.5020         31.02%   

 

174


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     91,133.9560         17.33%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     61,854.3100         11.76%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     107.6190         100.00%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

PALACE ENTERTAINMENT TTEE FBO

PALACE ENTERTAINMENT 401K

C/O FASCORE LLC

8515 E ORCHARD RD #2T2

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     29,872.0110         12.13%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MATC FBO

ANDERSON & VREELAND INC PSP

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

     25,872.0820         10.50%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     22,752.8750         9.24%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

CAPITAL BANK & TRUST CO

TTEE F FALASCA MECHANICAL INC

401K

8515 E ORCHARD RD #2T2

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     13,292.9880         5.40%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     164,348.5380         17.16%   

 

175


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     110.2780         100.00%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class Y

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     619.0670         100.00%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     19,841,200.6310         42.06%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     2,957,559.1610         6.27%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     9,135.3190         9.95%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     183,419.5700         30.05%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     93.0750         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     94.2680         100.00%   

 

176


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Y

  

ANCHORAGE POLICE & FIRE RETIREMENT SYSTEM

ATTN CHARLES M LAIRD

3600 DR MARTIN LUTHER KING JR AVE

STE 207

ANCHORAGE AK 99507-1222

     574,338.8870         99.91%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,930,461.6990         50.48%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     3,020,180.4990         10.21%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

     1,905,578.3390         6.44%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     605,226.9980         6.64%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     366,932.3080         27.69%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     195,471.8960         18.33%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     146.9720         100.00%   

 

177


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     147.3190         100.00%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     147.3190         100.00%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     625,701.5030         99.88%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     2,113,685.8780         6.22%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending September 30:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     55,204.9040         16.30%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     400,538.8090         25.71%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     196.8500         100.00%   

 

178


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     198.0980         100.00%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     2,904,076.6610         32.18%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     198.0980         100.00%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     11,895,818.9480         43.85%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     1,742,073.6190         6.37%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     1,646,036.7240         6.07%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,833,676.4450         6.39%   

 

179


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     323,006.5390         18.13%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,679,694.0770         21.34%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     505,894.0470         6.43%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     205.9310         100.00%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class R

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

     354,054.4290         50.12%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     72,943.3090         10.33%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class R

  

CAPITAL BANK & TRUST CO

TTEE F CHEMGLASS INC 401K

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     48,596.2770         6.88%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class T

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     1,729,484.3090         26.07%   

 

180


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,052,218.9670         15.86%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     206.1010         100.00%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     76,073,223.1810         58.11%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     9,604,889.3720         7.34%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     501,887.3690         6.97%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     93,881.2820         12.24%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     144,483.2790         17.15%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

BRIDGET NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O CHRISTOPHER M NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     3,133.0250         13.97%   

 

181


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

ANDREW NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O CHRISTOPHER M NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     3,132.6550         13.97%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

KAYLA HALL

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O MAUREEN HALL

49 RAYMOND PL

STATEN ISLAND NY 10310-2231

     2,804.7220         12.51%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

MIRANDA E KRAMER

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O LEIGH A NEUMANN

5203 SILVER FOX DR

JAMESVILLE NY 13078-8742

     2,617.7510         11.67%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

CLAIRE NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O ROBERT S NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     2,587.8420         11.54%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

LILY ELIZABETH KRAMER

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O LEIGH A NEUMANN

5203 SILVER FOX DR

JAMESVILLE NY 13078-8742

     2,582.3600         11.51%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

MATTHEW PATRICK NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O CHRISTOPHER M NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     2,572.5710         11.47%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     118.0360         100.00%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     120.8900         100.00%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,850,615.3180         26.36%   

 

182


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class W

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     120.8900         100.00%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,053,087.9350         99.94%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     15,661,903.8570         38.14%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     725,948.6660         7.96%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     456,353.2080         5.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     237,992.1060         18.27%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     223,748.8400         13.55%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     129,811.4340         7.86%   

 

183


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     100,824.8620         6.11%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     186.9860         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,853,281.8600         32.82%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     192.1600         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,295,990.1260         47.59%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,431,874.4850         11.42%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     2,230,417.1550         7.43%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

FIDELITY INVSTMNTS INSTITUTIONAL OPERATING CO FIIOC AGENT

FBO CERTAIN EMP BENEFIT PLANS

100 MAGELLAN WAY

COVINGTON KY 41015-1987

     1,612,451.1200         5.37%   

 

184


Table of Contents

 

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending October 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,458,758.9220         14.36%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     127,193.2490         31.57%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     378,486.5220         23.66%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     111,582.9250         6.98%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class C

  

PERSHING LLC

PO BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

     94,050.7650         5.88%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     313.3810         100.00%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Fund with fiscal year ending December 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

BARRETT A TOAN & PAULA OBRIAN JT TEN

42 PORTLAND PL

SAINT LOUIS MO 63108-1242

     246,430.2830         11.89%   

 

185


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     198,900.1270         9.64%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     38,577.2290         14.49%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.4040         100.00%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.7660         100.00%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.7660         100.00%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     10,537,887.6510         37.22%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     5,884,378.3790         20.78%   

 

186


Table of Contents

 

As of September 30, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “control person” (as that term is defined in the 1940 Act) of a Fund because it owns of record more than 25% of the outstanding shares of the Fund by virtue of its fiduciary roles with respect to its clients or otherwise, is shown below. A control person may be able to facilitate shareholder approval of proposals it approves and to impede shareholder approval of proposals it opposes. If a control person’s record ownership of a Fund’s outstanding shares exceeds 50%, then, for certain shareholder proposals, such control person may be able to approve, or prevent approval, of such proposals without regard to votes by other Fund shareholders.

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Bond Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     46,188,118.2470         60.75
Columbia Corporate Income Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     22,719,786.0950         46.74
Columbia Emerging Markets Fund   

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     10,150,197.5000         30.32
Columbia Emerging Markets Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     8,889,579.8000         26.55
Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     108,767,489.3180         45.05
Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,454,249.1510         30.30

 

187


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     174,231,681.5130         62.53
Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund   

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     36,097,426.4100         25.82

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending May 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     21,778,115.1400         26.07
Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     57,791,398.9660         71.62
Columbia International Bond Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     820,950.2480         54.08
Columbia International Bond Fund   

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     516,099.7760         34.00
Columbia Strategic Income Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     83,245,905.4230         25.21

 

188


Table of Contents

 

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending August 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     19,841,200.6310         37.86
Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,930,461.6990         44.56

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending September 30:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     11,895,878.9480         25.40
Columbia Dividend Income Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     76,073,223.1810         58.11
Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     16,714,991.7920         28.53
Columbia Small Cap Core Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,295,990.1260         29.93

 

189


Table of Contents

 

Control Person Ownership of the Fund with fiscal year ending December 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     10,537,887.6510         33.79

Bank of America, N.A. is a national banking association organized under the laws of the United States, 101 South Tryon Street, Charlotte, North Carolina 28255. Bank of America Corporation, a publicly-traded financial services corporation, is the ultimate parent company of Bank of America, N.A.

Charles Schwab & Co., Inc. is organized under the laws of the United States, 211 Main Street, San Francisco, California 94105. The Charles Schwab Corporation is the ultimate parent company of Charles Schwab & Co., Inc.

 

190


Table of Contents

 

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In June 2004, an action captioned John E. Gallus et al. v. American Express Financial Corp. and American Express Financial Advisors Inc., was filed in the United States District Court for the District of Arizona. The plaintiffs allege that they are investors in several American Express Company (now known as RiverSource) mutual funds and they purport to bring the action derivatively on behalf of those funds under the 1940 Act. The plaintiffs allege that fees allegedly paid to the defendants by the funds for investment advisory and administrative services are excessive. The plaintiffs seek remedies including restitution and rescission of investment advisory and distribution agreements. The plaintiffs voluntarily agreed to transfer this case to the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota (the District Court). In response to defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint, the District Court dismissed one of plaintiffs’ four claims and granted plaintiffs limited discovery. Defendants moved for summary judgment in April 2007. Summary judgment was granted in the defendants’ favor on July 9, 2007. The plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal with the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals (the Eighth Circuit) on August 8, 2007. On April 8, 2009, the Eighth Circuit reversed summary judgment and remanded to the District Court for further proceedings. On August 6, 2009, defendants filed a writ of certiorari with the U.S. Supreme Court (the Supreme Court), asking the Supreme Court to stay the District Court proceedings while the Supreme Court considered and ruled in a case captioned Jones v. Harris Associates, which involved issues of law similar to those presented in the Gallus case. On March 30, 2010, the Supreme Court issued its ruling in Jones v. Harris Associates, and on April 5, 2010, the Supreme Court vacated the Eighth Circuit’s decision in the Gallus case and remanded the case to the Eighth Circuit for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates. On June 4, 2010, the Eighth Circuit remanded the Gallus case to the District Court for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates.

In December 2005, without admitting or denying the allegations, American Express Financial Corporation (AEFC, which is now known as Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (Ameriprise Financial)), entered into settlement agreements with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and Minnesota Department of Commerce (MDOC) related to market timing activities. As a result, AEFC was censured and ordered to cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of certain provisions of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, the 1940 Act, and various Minnesota laws. AEFC agreed to pay disgorgement of $10 million and civil money penalties of $7 million. AEFC also agreed to retain an independent distribution consultant to assist in developing a plan for distribution of all disgorgement and civil penalties ordered by the SEC in accordance with various undertakings detailed at http://www.sec.gov/litigation/admin/ia-2451.pdf. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have cooperated with the SEC and the MDOC in these legal proceedings, and have made regular reports to the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds’ Boards of Directors/Trustees.

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions, and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that the Funds are not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial nor any of its affiliates are the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds. Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the SEC on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

There can be no assurance that these matters, or the adverse publicity associated with them, will not result in increased fund redemptions, reduced sale of fund shares or other adverse consequences to the Funds. Further, although we believe proceedings are not likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds, these proceedings are subject to uncertainties and, as such, we are unable to estimate the possible loss or range of loss that may result. An adverse outcome in one or more of these proceedings could result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties or other relief that could have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations of Ameriprise Financial.

 

191


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A — DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

This Appendix summarizes the various descriptions of securities ratings applicable to securities purchased by the Columbia Funds. Please refer to a Fund’s prospectus and statement of additional information to determine whether that Fund may invest in securities that have ratings described in this Appendix.

STANDARD & POOR’S (S&P)

Bonds

The following summarizes the ratings used by S&P for bonds. The ratings AAA, AA, A and BBB denote investment grade securities.

AAA bonds have the highest rating assigned by S&P and are considered to have an extremely strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

AA bonds are considered to have a very strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, and they differ from AAA only in small degree.

A bonds are considered to have a strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher rated categories.

BBB bonds are considered to have an adequate capacity to pay interest and repay principal. Whereas they normally exhibit adequate protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity to pay interest and repay principal than for bonds in the A category.

BB, B, CCC, CC and C bonds are considered to have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation. BB indicates the lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree. While such debt will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or large exposures to adverse conditions.

BB bonds are considered to have less near-term vulnerability to default than other speculative issues. However, they face major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments. The BB rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BBB – rating.

B bonds are considered to have a greater vulnerability to default but currently have the capacity to meet interest payments and principal repayments. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to pay interest and repay principal. The B rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BB or BB – rating.

CCC bonds are considered to have a currently identifiable vulnerability to default, and are dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions to meet timely payment of interest and repayment of principal. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the bonds are not likely to have the capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The CCC rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied B or B – rating.

CC rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC rating.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

C rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC – debt rating. The C rating may be used to cover a situation, for example, where a bankruptcy petition has been filed, but debt service payments are continued.

CI rating is reserved for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

D bonds are in payment default. The D rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments are not made on the date due even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made during such grace period. The D rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.

Plus (+) or minus (-): The ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus or minus sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

Municipal Notes

SP-1. Notes rated SP-1 are considered to have very strong or strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designated as SP-1+.

SP-2. Notes rated SP-2 are considered to have satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest.

Notes due in three years or less normally receive a note rating. Notes maturing beyond three years normally receive a bond rating, although the following criteria are used in making that assessment:

Amortization schedule (the larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely the issue will be rated as a note).

Source of payment (the more dependent the issue is on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it will be rated as a note).

Commercial Paper

A. Issues assigned this highest rating are regarded as having the greatest capacity for timely payment. Issues in this category are further refined with the designations 1, 2, and 3 to indicate the relative degree of safety.

A-1. Issues assigned to this rating are considered to have overwhelming or very strong capacity for timely payment. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designed A-1+.

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. (MOODY’S)

Municipal Bonds

Aaa bonds are considered to be of the best quality. They are considered to have the smallest degree of investment risk and are generally referred to as “gilt edge”. Interest payments are protected by a large or by an exceptionally stable margin and principal is secure. While various protective elements are likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair a fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Aa bonds are considered to be of high quality by all standards. Together with Aaa bonds they comprise what are generally known as high-grade bonds. They are rated lower than the best bonds because margins of protection may not be as large in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective elements may be of greater amplitude or there may be other elements present which make the long-term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

 

A-2


Table of Contents

 

Those bonds in the Aa through B groups that Moody’s believes possess the strongest investment attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1, A1 or Baa1.

A bonds are considered to possess many favorable investment attributes and are to be considered to be upper-medium-grade obligations. Factors giving security to principal and interest are considered adequate, but elements may be present that suggest a susceptibility to impairment at some time in the future.

Baa bonds are considered to be medium grade obligations: they are neither highly protected nor poorly secured. Interest payments and principal security appear adequate for the present but certain protective elements may be lacking or may be characteristically unreliable over any great period of time. Such bonds lack outstanding investment characteristics and, in fact, have speculative characteristics as well.

Ba bonds are considered to have speculative elements: their future cannot be considered as well secured. Often, the protection of interest and principal payments may be very moderate and thereby not well safeguarded during both good and bad times in the future. Uncertainty of position characterizes bonds in this grade.

B bonds are considered generally to lack characteristics of a desirable investment. Assurance of interest and principal payments or of maintenance of other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Caa bonds are considered to be of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Ca bonds are considered to represent obligations that are speculative in a high degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

C bonds are the lowest rated class of bonds and issues so rated are considered to have extremely poor prospects of ever attaining any real investment standing.

Conditional Ratings. Bonds for which the security depends upon the completion of some act or the fulfillment of some condition are rated conditionally. These are bonds secured by (a) earnings of projects under construction, (b) earnings of projects unseasoned in operating experience, (c) rentals which begin when facilities are completed, or (d) payments to which some other limiting conditions attach. Parenthetical rating denotes probable credit stature upon completion of construction or elimination of basis of condition.

Corporate Bonds

The description of the applicable rating symbols (Aaa, Aa, A, Baa, etc.) and their meanings is identical to that of the Municipal Bond ratings as set forth above, except for the numerical modifiers. Moody’s applies numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 in the Aa and A classifications of its corporate bond rating system. The modifier 1 indicates that the security ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a midrange ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates that the issuer ranks in the lower end of its generic rating category.

Municipal Notes

MIG 1. This designation denotes best quality. There is present strong protection by established cash flows, superior liquidity support or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.

MIG 2. This designation denotes high quality. Margins of protection are ample although not so large as in the preceding group.

 

A-3


Table of Contents

 

MIG 3. This designation denotes favorable quality. All security elements are accounted for, but there is lacking the undeniable strength of the preceding grades. Liquidity and cash flow protection may be narrow and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.

Commercial Paper

Moody’s employs the following three designations, all judged to be investment grade, to indicate the relative repayment capacity of rated issuers:

Prime-1 Highest Quality

Prime-2 Higher Quality

Prime-3 High Quality

If an issuer represents to Moody’s that its commercial paper obligations are supported by the credit of another entity or entities, Moody’s, in assigning ratings to such issuers, evaluates the financial strength of the indicated affiliated corporations, commercial banks, insurance companies, foreign governments, or other entities, but only as one factor in the total rating assessment.

FITCH, INC. (FITCH)

Long-Term Debt

Investment Grade Bond Ratings

AAA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of the highest credit quality. The obligor has an exceptionally strong ability to pay interest and/or dividends and repay principal, which is unlikely to be affected by reasonably foreseeable events.

AA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of very high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is very strong, although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA. Because bonds rated in the AAA and AA categories are not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable future developments, short-term debt of these issuers is generally rated F-1+.

A bonds are considered to be investment grade and of high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered to be strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances than debt securities with higher ratings.

BBB bonds are considered to be investment grade and of satisfactory credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest or dividends and repay principal is considered to be adequate. Adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances, however, are more likely to have adverse impact on these securities and, therefore, impair timely payment. The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall below investment grade is higher than for securities with higher ratings.

Speculative Grade Bond Ratings

BB bonds are considered speculative. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes. However, business and financial alternatives can be identified, which could assist the obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B bonds are considered highly speculative. While securities in this class are currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely payment of principal and interest reflects the obligor’s limited margin of safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the life of the issue.

 

A-4


Table of Contents

 

CCC bonds are considered to have certain identifiable characteristics that, if not remedied, may lead to default. The ability to meet obligations requires an advantageous business and economic environment.

CC bonds are considered to be minimally protected. Default in payment of interest and/or principal seems probable over time.

C bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments. Such securities are extremely speculative and should be valued on the basis of their ultimate recovery value in liquidation or reorganization of the obligor. DDD represents the highest potential for recovery on these securities and D represents the lowest potential for recovery.

Plus (+) or minus (-): Plus or minus signs are used to show relative standing within the major rating categories. Plus and minus signs, however, are not used in the DDD, DD, or D categories.

Short-Term Debt

Fitch’s short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand or have original maturities of up to three years, including commercial paper, certificates of deposit, medium-term notes, and investment notes.

F-1+ obligations have exceptionally strong credit quality and are considered to have the strongest degree of assurance for timely payment.

F-1 obligations are considered to reflect an assurance of timely payment only slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2 obligations are considered to have good credit quality. Securities in this class have a satisfactory degree of assurance for timely payment, but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned F-1+ and F-1 ratings.

F-3 obligations are considered to have characteristics suggesting that the degree of assurance for timely payment is adequate; however, near-term adverse changes could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a minimal degree of assurance for timely payment and to be vulnerable to near-term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions.

B obligations are considered to have a minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments and a susceptibility to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

C rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a high default risk and whose capacity for meeting financial commitments is solely reliant upon a sustained, favorable business and economic environment.

D obligations are in actual or imminent payment default.

 

A-5


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B — PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT INVESTMENT ADVISERS, LLC

PROXY VOTING POLICY FOR LEGACY COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT CLIENTS

EFFECTIVE MAY 1, 2010

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (CMIA) has adopted the attached Proxy Voting Policy for purposes of voting proxies of securities held in certain client accounts1, with the following changes:

 

   

References to Columbia Management Advisors, LLC and CMA are deemed to be references to Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC; and

 

   

References to Bank of America Corporation and BAC are deemed to be references to Ameriprise Financial, Inc.

In addition, the text of footnote 1 in the Proxy Voting Policy is hereby deleted and replaced with the following:

Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the corporate parent of Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, and all of its numerous affiliates own, operate and have interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between Ameriprise Financial, Inc. or its affiliates and those of clients advised by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. For example, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. and its affiliates may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

1 On April 30, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of CMIA, acquired from Bank of America, N.A. a portion of the asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC, the parent company of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”). In connection with this transaction, CMIA became the investment adviser of certain client accounts previously advised by CMA. CMIA will apply CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy to certain of these and other client accounts.

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) Proxy Voting Policy

 

Last Review Date:

   April 2010
Applicable Regulatory Authority:   

Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940

Form N-PX

ERISA Department of Labor Bulletin 08-2

Institutional Shareholder Services, Inc. (SEC No Action Letter dated September 15, 2004)

Explanation/Summary of Regulatory Requirements

An investment adviser that exercises voting authority over clients’ proxies must adopt written policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that those proxies are voted in the best economic interests of clients. An adviser’s policies and procedures must address how the adviser resolves material conflicts of interest between its interests and those of its clients. An investment adviser must comply with certain record keeping and disclosure requirements with respect to its proxy voting responsibilities. In addition, an investment adviser to Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) accounts has an affirmative obligation to vote proxies for an ERISA account, unless the client expressly retains proxy voting authority.

Policy Summary

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) has adopted and implemented the following policy, which it believes is reasonably designed to: (1) ensure that proxies are voted in the best economic interest of clients; and (2) address material conflicts of interest that may arise. This policy applies primarily to the Global Wealth and Investment Management (“GWIM”) Investment Operations Group, the Investment groups (particularly, Equity and Chief Investment Officer’s Office), as well as to Compliance Risk Management (“CRM”) and Legal. CRM and Business groups to which this policy directly applies must adopt written procedures to implement this Policy.

Policy

All proxies regarding client securities for which CMA has authority to vote will, unless CMA determines in accordance with policies stated below to refrain from voting, be voted in a manner considered by CMA to be in the best interest of CMA’s clients without regard to any resulting benefit or detriment to CMA, its associates, or its affiliates. The best interest of clients is defined for this purpose as the interest of enhancing or protecting the economic value of client accounts, considered as a group rather than individually, as CMA determines in its sole and absolute discretion. In the event a client believes that its other interests require a different vote, CMA will vote as the client clearly instructs, provided CMA receives such instructions in time to act accordingly. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential. Therefore, the information may be shared on a need to know basis only, including within CMA and with CMA affiliates. Advisory clients, including mutual funds’ and other funds’ boards, may obtain information on how their proxies were voted by CMA. However, CMA will not selectively disclose its investment company clients’ proxy voting records to third parties. Rather, the investment company clients’ proxy records will be disclosed to shareholders by publicly-available annual filings for 12-month periods ending each year on June 30th on Form N-PX.

CMA endeavors to vote, in accordance with this Policy, all proxies of which it becomes aware prior to the vote deadline date, subject to certain general exceptions described below.

CMA seeks to avoid the occurrence of actual or apparent material conflicts of interest in the proxy voting process by voting in accordance with predetermined voting guidelines and observing other procedures that are intended to prevent where practicable and manage conflicts of interest (refer to Conflicts of Interest section below). CMA’s proxy voting policy and practices are summarized in its Form ADV. Additionally, CMA will provide clients with a copy of its policies, as they may be updated from time to time, upon request.

 

B-2


Table of Contents

 

Means of Achieving Compliance

The Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations is primarily responsible for overseeing the day-to-day operations of the proxy voting process. The Proxy Group’s monitoring will take into account the following elements: (1) periodic review of the proxy vendor’s votes to ensure that the proxy vendor is accurately voting consistent with CMA’s Voting Guidelines; and (2) review of the Columbia Funds’ fund website to ensure that annual proxy voting reports are posted in a timely and accurate manner. CMA has established a Proxy Committee which is responsible for overseeing the proxy voting process.

The specific responsibilities of the Proxy Committee and scope of its oversight are described in the Proxy Committee’s charter.

CMA’S INVESTMENT ASSOCIATES’ RESPONSIBILITIES

Under CMA’s Voting Guidelines, certain matters must be determined on a case-by-case basis. In general, the Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations will refer these matters first to the relevant CMA research analyst after first confirming that the proxy matter does not present a potential conflict to CMA. If there is not a research analyst assigned to the particular security, the matter will be referred to the appropriate portfolio manager.

In considering a particular proxy matter, the research analyst or portfolio manager must vote in the clients’ best interest as defined above. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential information. Therefore, research analysts and portfolio managers generally must not discuss proxy votes with any person outside of CMA and within CMA except on a need to know basis only.

Research analysts and portfolio managers must discharge their responsibilities consistent with the obligations set forth below (refer to Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures). A research analyst or portfolio manager must disclose in writing any inappropriate attempt to influence their recommendation or any other personal interest that they have with the issuer (see Appendix B – Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form). For each Proxy Referral (defined below), the research analyst or portfolio manager is responsible for memorializing their recommendation on the Proxy Voting Recommendation Form (see Appendix C) and communicating their recommendation to the Proxy Group.

Research analysts and portfolio managers should seek advice from CRM or Legal with respect to any questions that they have regarding personal conflicts of interests, communications regarding proxies, or other related matters.

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

For purposes of this policy, a material conflict of interest is a relationship or activity engaged in by CMA, a CMA affiliate1, or a CMA associate that creates an incentive (or appearance thereof) to favor the interests of CMA, the affiliate, or associate, rather than the clients’ interests. However, a material conflict of interest is not automatically created when there is a relationship or activity engaged in by a CMA affiliate, but there is a possibility that a CMA affiliate could cause a conflict. CMA may have a conflict of interest if either CMA has a significant business relationship with a company that is soliciting a proxy, or if a CMA associate involved in the proxy voting decision-making process has a significant personal or family relationship with the particular

 

1 Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”), the ultimate corporate parent of CMA, Bank of America, N.A. and all of their numerous affiliates owns, operates and has interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between BAC or its affiliates and those of CMA-advised clients. For example, the commercial and investment banking business lines may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with CMA’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

B-3


Table of Contents

company. A conflict of interest is considered to be “material” to the extent that a reasonable person could expect the conflict to influence CMA’s decision on the particular vote at issue. In all cases where there is deemed to be a material conflict of interest, CMA will seek to resolve said conflict in the clients’ best interests.

For those proxy proposals that: (1) are not addressed by CMA’s proxy voting guidelines; (2) the guidelines specify the issue must be evaluated and determined on a case-by-case basis; or (3) a CMA investment associate believes that an exception to the guidelines may be in the best economic interest of CMA’s clients (collectively, “Proxy Referrals”), CMA may vote the proxy, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures set forth below.

In the case of Proxy Referrals, CRM identifies companies with which CMA has a significant business relationships and Proxy Referrals of such companies will be voted consistent with CMA’s conflicts management procedures described below. For Proxy Referrals that do not involve companies with which CMA has a significant business relationship the relevant CMA investment personnel (i.e. research analyst, portfolio manager, members of Proxy Committee) involved in the particular Proxy Referral must report any personal conflict of interest circumstances (e.g., relationships with nominees for directorship, members of an issuer’s or dissident’s management or otherwise, unusual communications with parties outside the investment organization concerning a proxy matter) to Columbia Management’s Conflicts of Interest Officer in writing (see Appendix B). In the event any member of the Proxy Committee has a conflict of interest regarding a given matter, he or she will similarly disclose the circumstance and abstain from participating in the Committee’s determination of whether and/or how to vote in the matter.

If the Proxy Committee, the Chairperson of the Proxy Committee, or the Conflicts Officer determines that a proxy matter presents a material conflict of interest, or a material conflict of interest is otherwise determined to exist through the application of this Policy, CMA will invoke one or more of the following conflict management procedures:

 

   

Causing the proxies to be voted in accordance with the recommendations of an independent third party (which generally will be CMA’s proxy voting agent);

 

   

Causing the proxies to be delegated to a qualified, independent third party, which may include CMA’s proxy voting agent; or

 

   

In unusual cases, with the Client’s consent and upon ample notice, forwarding the proxies to CMA’s clients so that they may vote the proxies directly.

Affiliate Investment Companies and Public Companies

CMA considers (1) proxies solicited by open-end and closed-end investment companies for which CMA or an affiliate serves as an investment adviser or principal underwriter; and (2) proxies solicited by Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”) or other public companies within the BAC organization to present a material conflict of interest for CMA. Consequently, the proxies of such affiliates will be voted following one of the conflict management practices discussed above.

Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures

In certain circumstances, CMA follows the proxy guidelines and uses other research services provided by the proxy vendor or another independent third party. CMA reviews its proxy vendor’s conflicts of interest procedures as part of its oversight of the proxy vendor’s services.

CMA and other BAC affiliates have adopted various other policies and procedures that help reinforce this Policy. Please see any associated documents.

Ownership Limits – Delegation of Proxy Voting to an Independent Third Party

From time to time, CMA may face regulatory or compliance limits on the types or amounts of voting securities that it may purchase or hold for client accounts. Among other limits, federal, state, foreign regulatory restrictions, or company-specific ownership limits may restrict the total percentage of an issuer’s voting securities that CMA can hold for clients (collectively, “Ownership Limits”).

 

B-4


Table of Contents

 

The regulations or company-specific documents governing a number of these Ownership Limits often focus upon holdings in voting securities. As a result, in limited circumstances in order to comply with such Ownership Limits and/or internal policies designed to comply with such limits, CMA may delegate proxy voting in certain issuers to a qualified, independent third party, who may be CMA’s proxy voting agent.

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

A. CMA’s Proxy Voting Guidelines – General Practices.

The Proxy Committee has adopted the guidelines for voting proxies specified in Appendix A of this policy. CMA uses an independent, third-party proxy vendor to implement its proxy voting process as CMA’s proxy voting agent. In general, whenever a vote is solicited, the proxy vendor will execute the vote according to CMA’s Voting Guidelines.

B. Ability to Vote Proxies Other than as Provided by Voting Guidelines.

A Portfolio Manager or other party involved with a client’s account may conclude that the best interest of the firm’s client, as defined above, requires that a proxy be voted in a manner that differs from the predetermined proxy Voting Guidelines. In this situation, he or she will request in writing that the Proxy Committee consider voting the proxy other than according to such Guidelines and provide information as the Proxy Committee may request. The Proxy Committee may consider the matter, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures discussed above.

C. Other Proxy Matters

For the following categories, proxies will be voted as stated below:

1. New Proposals. For certain new proposals that are expected to be proposed to shareholders of multiple companies, the Proxy Committee may develop a Voting Guideline which will be incorporated into this Policy.

2. Accounts Adhering to Taft Hartley Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to Taft Hartley principles will be voted according to the Taft Hartley Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor.

3. Accounts Adhering to Socially Responsible Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to socially responsible principles will be voted according to the Socially Responsible Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client.

4. Proxies of International Issuers. In general, CMA will refrain from voting securities in cases where international issuers impose share blocking restrictions. However, in the exceptional circumstances that CMA determines that it would be appropriate to vote such securities, all proposals for these securities will be voted only on the specific instruction of the Proxy Committee and to the extent practicable in accordance with the Voting Guidelines set forth in this Policy. Additionally, proxies will typically not be voted in markets where powers of attorney are required to be executed in order to vote shares.

5. Proxy Referrals for Passive Index Accounts. Proxy Referrals for a security that is held only within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and not in any other account within CMA, shall be voted according to the guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client. However, if a security is held within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and within another CMA-managed account (including without limitation an account actively managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group), all proposals, including Proxy Referrals, will be voted in accordance with the Voting Guidelines, subject to the other provisions of this Policy.

6. Proxy Voting for Securities on Loan. CMA generally votes in cases where shares have been loaned from actively managed Columbia Funds as long as the shares have been recalled in a timely manner. However, CMA generally does not vote shares that have been loaned from passively managed Columbia Index Funds. Other CMA clients may have their own stock loan programs and may or may not recall their shares for proxy voting.

 

B-5


Table of Contents

 

Supervision

Managers and supervisory personnel are responsible for ensuring that their associates understand and follow this policy and any applicable procedures adopted by the business group to implement the policy. The Proxy Committee has ultimate responsibility for the implementation of this Policy.

Escalation

With the exception of conflicts of interest-related matters, issues arising under this policy should be escalated to the Proxy Committee. Issues involving potential or actual conflicts of interest should be promptly communicated to the Columbia Management Conflicts Officer.

Monitoring/Oversight

CRM and/or Corporate Internal Audit Group perform periodic reviews and assessments of various lines of businesses, including a review of Columbia Management’s compliance with the Proxy Voting Policy.

Recordkeeping

CMA will create and maintain records of each investment company’s proxy record for 12-month periods ended June 30th. CMA will compile the following information for each matter relating to a portfolio security considered at any shareholder meeting during the period covered by the annual report and for which CMA was entitled to vote:

 

   

The name of the issuer of the security;

 

   

The exchange ticker symbol of the portfolio security (if symbol is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The Council on Uniform Securities Identification Procedures number for the portfolio security (if number is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The shareholder meeting date;

 

   

A brief identification of the matter voted on;

 

   

Whether the matter was proposed by the issuer or by a security holder;

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote on the matter;

 

   

How the company cast its vote (e.g., for or against proposal, or abstain; for or withhold regarding the election of directors); and

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote for or against management.

Business groups and support partners are responsible for maintaining all records necessary to evidence compliance with this policy. The records must be properly maintained and readily accessible in order to evidence compliance with this policy.

 

B-6


Table of Contents

 

These records include:

 

Document

  

Responsible Party

Proxy Committee Meeting Minutes and Related Materials    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Proxy Vote Recommendation Form and Supporting Materials of Investment Management Personnel Concerning Proxy Decisions and Recommendations (or any other document created by CMA that was material to making a voting decision or that memorializes the basis for the voting decision)    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Conflicts of Interest Review Documentation, including Conflicts of Interest Forms    Compliance Risk Management
Client Communications Regarding Proxy Matters    Client Service Group
Copy of Each Applicable Proxy Statement Unless it has been Filed with the SEC and may be Obtained from the SEC’s EDGAR System    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations

Records should be retained for a period of not less than six years plus the current year. Records must be retained in an appropriate office of CM for the first three years.

 

B-7


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A – CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy

CMA’S VOTING GUIDELINES

A. The Proxy Committee has adopted the following guidelines for voting proxies:

1. Matters Relating to the Board of Directors/Corporate Governance

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals for the election of directors or for an increase or decrease in the number of directors, provided that no more than one-third of the Board of Directors would, presently or at any time during the previous three-year period, be from management.

However, CMA generally will WITHHOLD votes from pertinent director nominees if:

 

  (i) the board as proposed to be constituted would have more than one-third of its members from management;

 

  (ii) the board does not have audit, nominating, and compensation committees composed solely of directors who qualify as being regarded as “independent,” i.e. having no material relationship, directly or indirectly, with the Company, as CMA’s proxy voting agent may determine (subject to the Proxy Committee’s contrary determination of independence or non-independence);

 

  (iii) the nominee, as a member of the audit committee, permitted the company to incur excessive non-audit fees (as defined below regarding other business matters — ratification of the appointment of auditors);

 

  (iv) a director serves on more than six public company boards;

 

  (v) the CEO serves on more than two public company boards other than the company’s board; or

 

  (vi) CMA generally will vote AGAINST Director nominee of a company who is chief executive officer of another company on whose board the company’s chief executive officer sits (i.e. interlocking executives).

One a CASE-BY-CASE basis, CMA may WITHHOLD votes for a director nominee who has failed to observe good corporate governance practices or, through specific corporate action or inaction (e.g. failing to implement policies for which a majority of shareholders has previously cast votes in favor; served voted for the adoption of a poison pill without approval of shareholders), has demonstrated a disregard for the interests of shareholders.

 

   

Proposals requesting that the board audit, compensation and/or nominating committee be composed solely of independent directors. The Audit Committee must satisfy the independence and experience requirements established by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and the New York Stock Exchange, or appropriate local requirements for foreign securities. At least one member of the Audit Committee must qualify as a “financial expert” in accordance with SEC rules.

 

   

Proposals to declassify a board, absent special circumstances that would indicate that shareholder interests are better served by a classified board structure.

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to separate the role of Chairman of the Board and CEO.

 

   

Proposals that grant or restore shareholder ability to remove directors with or without cause.

 

   

Proposals to permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that encourage directors to own a minimum amount of company stock.

 

   

Proposals to provide or to restore shareholder appraisal rights.

 

   

Proposals for the company to adopt confidential voting.

 

B-8


Table of Contents

 

CMA will generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for majority voting thresholds for director elections unless the company has adopted formal corporate governance principles that present a meaningful alternative to the majority voting standard and/or provides an adequate response to both new nominees as well as incumbent nominees who fail to receive a majority of votes cast.

CMA will generally vote FOR 162(m) bonus plans unless the Proxy Administrator recommends voting against a specific plan, in which case CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to classify boards, absent special circumstances indicating that shareholder interests would be better served by a classified board structure.

 

   

Proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board without shareholder approval.

 

   

Proposals that provide directors may be removed only by supermajority vote.

 

   

Proposals which allow more than one vote per share in the election of directors.

 

   

Proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that mandate a minimum amount of company stock that directors must own.

 

   

Proposals to limit the tenure of non-management directors.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

In contested elections of directors. Proposals to adopt or eliminate cumulative voting.

 

   

CMA generally will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on board approved proposals relating to corporate governance. Such proposals include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Reimbursement of proxy solicitation expenses taking into consideration whether or not CMA was in favor of the dissidents.

 

   

Proxy contest advance notice. CMA generally will vote FOR proposals that allow shareholders to submit proposals as close to the meeting date as possible while allowing for sufficient time for Company response, SEC review, and analysis by other shareholders.

 

   

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis to indemnify directors and officers, and AGAINST proposals to indemnify external auditors.

 

   

CMA will vote FOR the indemnification of internal auditors, unless the costs associated with the approval are not disclosed.

2. Compensation

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

CMA generally will vote FOR management sponsored compensation plans (such as bonus plans, incentive plans, stock option plans, pension and retirement benefits, stock purchase plans or thrift plans) if they are consistent with industry and country standards.

 

   

Proposals requiring that executive severance arrangements be submitted for shareholder ratification.

 

   

Proposals asking a company to expense stock options.

 

   

Proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

 

   

Employee stock purchase plans that have the following features: (i) the shares purchased under the plan are acquired for no less than 85% of their market value, (ii) the offering period under the plan is 27 months or less, and (iii) dilution is 10% or less.

 

B-9


Table of Contents

 

   

Shareholder proposals to adopt a non-binding advisory vote on Executive Compensation (“Say on Pay”).

 

   

CMA recognizes that individual compensation committees are in the best position to determine the optimal design of share based plans. However, CMA generally prefers a greater use of restricted stock in place of stock options due to the greater uncertainty involved with the valuation of stock options at the time of issue.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Stock option plans that permit issuance of options with an exercise price below the stock’s current market price, or that permit replacing or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals to authorize the replacement or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals requesting that plan administrators have advance authority to amend the terms of a plan without detailed disclosure of the specific amendments. When sufficient details are provided on the amendments permitted by the advance authority, CMA will recommend on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

CMA generally is opposed to compensation plans that substantially dilute ownership interest in a company, provide participants with excessive awards, or have objectionable structural features. Specifically, for equity-based plans, if the proposed number of shares authorized for option programs (excluding authorized shares for expired options) exceeds 5% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years, or exceeds 1% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years (for directors only), CMA will vote on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. CMA requires that management provide substantial justification for the repricing of options.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals regarding approval of specific executive severance arrangements.

 

   

-Management proposals regarding “Say on Pay” (i.e. non-binding advisory vote on pay).

 

   

Proposals that involve awarding 50% or more of the equity shares of an equity-based compensation plan to the top five or fewer executives.

3. Capitalization

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to increase the authorized shares for stock dividends, stock splits (and reverse stock splits) or general issuance, unless proposed as an anti-takeover measure or a general issuance proposal increases the authorization by more than 30% without a clear need presented by the company. Proposals for reverse stock splits should include an overall reduction in authorization.

For companies recognizing preemptive rights for existing shareholders, CMA generally will vote FOR general issuance proposals that increase the authorized shares by more than 30%. CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all such proposals by companies that do not recognize preemptive rights for existing shareholders.

 

   

Proposals for the elimination of authorized but unissued shares or retirement of those shares purchased for sinking fund or treasury stock.

 

   

Proposals to institute/renew open market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

 

   

Proposals to reduce or change the par value of common stock, provided the number of shares is also changed in order to keep the capital unchanged.

 

B-10


Table of Contents

 

CMA will evaluate on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals regarding:

 

   

Management proposals that allow listed companies to de-list and terminate the registration of their common stock. CMA will determine whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by giving consideration to:

 

   

Whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly traded.

 

   

Cash-out value

 

   

Balanced interests of continuing vs. cashed-out shareholders

 

   

Market reaction to public announcement of transaction

4. Mergers, Restructurings and Other Transactions

CMA will review, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, business transactions such as mergers, acquisitions, reorganizations, liquidations, spinoffs, buyouts and sale of all or substantially all of a company’s assets.

5. Anti-Takeover Measures

CMA generally will vote AGAINST proposals intended largely to avoid acquisition prior to the occurrence of an actual event or to discourage acquisition by creating a cost constraint. With respect to the following measures, CMA generally will vote as follows:

Poison Pills

 

   

CMA votes FOR shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification.

 

   

CMA generally votes FOR shareholder proposals to eliminate a poison pill.

 

   

CMA generally votes AGAINST management proposals to ratify a poison pill.

 

Greenmail

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or to otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

Supermajority vote

 

   

CMA will vote AGAINST board-approved proposals to adopt anti-takeover measures such as supermajority voting provisions, issuance of blank check preferred stock, the creation of a separate class of stock with disparate voting rights and charter amendments adopting control share acquisition provisions.

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share acquisition statutes.

6. Other Business Matters

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Bylaw amendments giving holders of at least 25% of outstanding common stock the ability to call a special meeting of stockholders.

 

   

Board governance document amendments or other proposals which give the lead independent director the authority to call special meetings of the independent directors at any time.

 

B-11


Table of Contents

 

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to approve routine business matters such as changing the company’s name and procedural matters relating to the shareholder meeting such as approving the minutes of a prior meeting.

 

   

Proposals to ratify the appointment of auditors, unless any of the following apply in which case CMA will generally vote AGAINST the proposal:

 

   

Credible reason exists to question:

 

   

The auditor’s independence, as determined by applicable regulatory requirements.

 

   

The accuracy or reliability of the auditor’s opinion as to the company’s financial position.

 

   

Fees paid to the auditor or its affiliates for “non-audit” services exceeds 25% of the total fees paid for “audit,” “audit-related” and “tax compliance” and/or “tax return preparation” services, as disclosed in the company’s proxy materials.

 

   

Bylaw or charter changes that are of a housekeeping nature (e.g., updates or corrections).

 

   

Proposals to approve the annual reports and accounts provided the certifications required by the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 have been provided.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to eliminate the right of shareholders to act by written consent or call special meetings.

 

   

Proposals providing management with authority to adjourn an annual or special shareholder meeting absent compelling reasons, or to adopt, amend or repeal bylaws without shareholder approval, or to vote unmarked proxies in favor of management.

 

   

Shareholder proposals to change the date, time or location of the company’s annual meeting of shareholders.

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Authorization to transact other unidentified substantive (as opposed to procedural) business at a meeting.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals to change the location of the company’s state of incorporation. CMA considers whether financial benefits (e.g., reduced fees or taxes) likely to accrue to the company as a result of a reincorporation or other change of domicile outweigh any accompanying material diminution of shareholder rights.

 

   

Proposals on whether and how to vote on “bundled” or otherwise conditioned proposals, depending on the overall economic effects upon shareholders.

CMA generally will ABSTAIN from voting on shareholder proposals predominantly involving social, socio-economic, environmental, political or other similar matters on the basis that their impact on share value can rarely be anticipated with any high degree of confidence. CMA may, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, vote:

 

   

FOR proposals seeking inquiry and reporting with respect to, rather than cessation or affirmative implementation of, specific policies where the pertinent issue warrants separate communication to shareholders; and

 

   

FOR or AGAINST the latter sort of proposal in light of the relative benefits and detriments (e.g. distraction, costs, other burdens) to share value which may be expected to flow from passage of the proposal.

 

B-12


Table of Contents

 

7. Other Matters Relating to Foreign Issues

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Most stock (scrip) dividend proposals. CMA votes AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

 

   

Proposals to capitalize the company’s reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase the par value of shares.

 

   

Proposals to approve control and profit transfer agreements between a parent and its subsidiaries.

 

   

Management proposals seeking the discharge of management and supervisory board members, unless there is concern about the past actions of the company’s auditors/directors and/or legal action is being taken against the board by other shareholders.

 

   

Management proposals concerning allocation of income and the distribution of dividends, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

Proposals for the adoption of financing plans if they are in the best economic interests of shareholders.

CMA will generally vote FOR proposals to approve Directors’ Fees, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA will evaluate management proposals to approve protective preference shares for Netherlands located company-friendly foundations proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis and will only support resolutions if:

 

   

The supervisory board needs to approve an issuance of shares while the supervisory board is independent within the meaning of CMA’s categorization rules and the Dutch Corporate Governance Code.

 

   

No call/put option agreement exists between the company and the foundation.

 

   

There is a qualifying offer clause or there are annual management and supervisory board elections.

 

   

The issuance authority is for a maximum of 18 months.

 

   

The board of the company-friendly foundation is independent.

 

   

The company has disclosed under what circumstances it expects to make use of the possibility to issue preference shares.

 

   

There are no priority shares or other egregious protective or entrenchment tools.

 

   

The company releases its proxy circular, with details of the poison pill proposal, at least three weeks prior to the meeting.

 

   

Art 2:359c Civil Code of the legislative proposal has been implemented.

8. Investment Company Matters

Election of Directors:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the election of directors, considering the following factors:

 

   

Board structure

 

   

Attendance at board and committee meetings.

 

B-13


Table of Contents

 

CMA will WITHHOLD votes from directors who:

 

   

Attend less than 75 percent of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse for the absences. Valid reasons include illness or absence due to company business. Participation via telephone is acceptable. In addition, if the director missed only one meeting or one day’s meetings, votes should not be withheld even if such absence dropped the director’s attendance below 75 percent.

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal that is approved by a majority of shares outstanding;

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal this is approved by a majority of the votes cast for two consecutive years;

 

   

Are interested directors and sit on the audit or nominating committee; or

 

   

Are interested directors and the full board serves as the audit or nominating committee or the company does not have one of these committees.

Proxy Contests:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for proxy contests, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance relative to its peers

 

   

Market in which fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the pertinent issues (e.g., closed-end fund share market value discount to NAV)

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity and votes on related proposals

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents

 

   

Independence of incumbent directors; director nominees

 

   

Experience and skills of director nominees

 

   

Governance profile of the company

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund:

CMA will vote conversion proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance as a closed-end fund

 

   

Market in which the fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the discount

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals.

Investment Advisory Agreements:

CMA will vote investment advisory agreements on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Proposed and current fee schedules

 

   

Fund category/investment objective

 

   

Performance benchmarks

 

   

Share price performance as compared with peers

 

   

Resulting fees relative to peers

 

   

Assignments (where the adviser undergoes a change of control)

 

B-14


Table of Contents

 

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of new classes or series of shares.

Preferred Stock Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the authorization for or increase in the preferred shares, considering the following factors:

 

   

Stated specific financing purpose

 

   

Possible dilution for common shares

 

   

Whether the shares can be used for anti-takeover purposes

Policies Addressed by the Investment Company Act of 1940 (“1940 Act”):

CMA will vote proposals regarding adoption or changes of policies addressed by the 1940 Act on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Regulatory developments

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Current and potential risk

CMA generally will vote FOR these amendments as long as the proposed changes do not fundamentally alter the investment focus of the fund and do comply with current SEC interpretations.

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Non-fundamental Restriction:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fundamental restriction to a non-fundamental restriction, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fund’s target investments

 

   

Reasons given by the fund for the change

 

   

Projected impact of the change on the portfolio

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Non-fundamental:

CMA will vote AGAINST proposals to change a fund’s investment objective from fundamental to non-fundamental unless management acknowledges meaningful limitations upon its future requested ability to change the objective

Name Change Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s name, considering the following factors:

 

   

Political/economic changes in the target market

 

   

Consolidation in the target market

 

   

Current asset composition

 

B-15


Table of Contents

 

Change in Fund’s Subclassification:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s subclassification, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Risk of concentration

 

   

Consolidation in target industry

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis these proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Strategies employed to salvage the company

 

   

Past performance of the fund

 

   

Terms of the liquidation

Changes to the Charter Document:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change the charter document, considering the following factors:

 

   

The degree of change implied by the proposal

 

   

The efficiencies that could result

 

   

The state of incorporation; net effect on shareholder rights

 

   

Regulatory standards and implications

CMA will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals allowing the Board to impose, without shareholder approval, fees payable upon redemption of fund shares, provided imposition of such fees is likely to benefit long-term fund investors (e.g., by deterring market timing activity by other fund investors)

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to amend, without shareholder approval, the fund’s management agreement(s) with its investment adviser(s) or sub-advisers, provided the amendment is not required by applicable law (including the Investment Company Act of 1940) or interpretations thereunder to require such approval

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to:

 

   

Change, without shareholder approval the domicile of the fund

 

   

Adopt, without shareholder approval, material amendments of the fund’s declaration of trust or other organizational document

Changing the Domicile of a Fund:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reincorporate, considering the following factors:

 

   

Regulations of both states

 

   

Required fundamental policies of both states

 

   

The increased flexibility available

 

B-16


Table of Contents

 

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval:

CMA will vote FOR proposals to enable the Board or Investment Adviser to hire and terminate sub-advisers, without shareholder approval, in accordance with applicable rules or exemptive orders under the Investment Company Act of 1940

Distribution Agreements:

CMA will vote these proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fees charged to comparably sized funds with similar objectives

 

   

The proposed distributor’s reputation and past performance

 

   

The competitiveness of the fund in the industry

 

   

Terms of the agreement

Master-Feeder Structure:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of a master-feeder structure.

Mergers:

CMA will vote merger proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Resulting fee structure

 

   

Performance of both funds

 

   

Continuity of management personnel

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights

Shareholder Proposals to Establish Director Ownership Requirement:

CMA will generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a specific minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board. While CMA favors stockownership on the part of directors, the company should determine the appropriate ownership requirement.

Shareholder Proposals to Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses.

Shareholder Proposals to Terminate the Investment Adviser:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to terminate the investment adviser, considering the following factors:

 

   

Performance of the fund’s NAV

 

   

The fund’s history of shareholder relations

 

   

The performance of other funds under the adviser’s management

 

B-17


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B

Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form

Conflict Review Questionnaire for Proxy Voting Working Group Members and Other Individuals

Participating in the Proxy Voting Decision-Making Process.

Instructions: Please complete each of the questions. Please provide an explanation for any affirmative responses. Return the completed questionnaire to Columbia Management Conflicts of Interest Officer.

 

 

 

Issuer and Proxy Matter:      

 

 

 

 

  1. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any management personnel of the issuer1?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  2. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any person participating, supporting, opposing or otherwise connected with the particular proxy proposal (e.g., principals of the issuer; director nominees of issuer company; shareholder activists)?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  3. Have you discussed this particular proxy proposal with anyone outside of Columbia Management’s investment group2?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

 

  4. Are you aware of any other potential personal conflicts of interest not described above? Please detail below.

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

Name:      
Signed:      
Date:      

 

1 Personal investing in the issuer by you or a member of your immediate family does not require an affirmative response to this item.
2 Communications with issuer or solicitors in the regular course of business would not have to be disclosed on this form.

 

B-18


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C

CMA Proxy Vote Recommendation/Proxy Committee Request Form

 

Name of Investment Associate:      

 

Company Name:      

 

Overview of Proxy Vote and Meeting Date:      

 

 

 

Proxy Agenda Item(s)

 

Description of Item:      
 
(The above information will be pre-populated by the Proxy Department.)

 

Recommendation (FOR, AGAINST, ABSTAIN) including brief rationale:      

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Please attach any supporting information other than analysis or reports provided by the Proxy Department.

 

 

 

Signed

By signing, I am certifying that I either have no conflicts of interest-related information to report or have sent a completed “Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form” to Compliance Risk Management (Conflicts Officer).

 

 

Send Completed Forms to:

GWIM Investment Operations – Proxy Department

        or

In the case of Proxy Votes to be referred to the Proxy Committee, submit this form and materials to the Chair of the Proxy Committee

 

B-19


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C — SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

 

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares, Class R5 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

C-3


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX D — DESCRIPTION OF STATE RISK FACTORS

State Tax Exempt Funds

The state tax-exempt Funds invest primarily in municipal securities issued by a single state and political sub-divisions of that state. Each Fund will be particularly affected by political and economic conditions and developments in the state in which it invests. This vulnerability to factors affecting the state’s tax-exempt investments will be significantly greater than that of more geographically diversified funds, and may result in greater losses and volatility. Because of the relatively small number of issuers of tax-exempt securities, the Fund may invest a higher percentage of assets in a single issuer and, therefore, be more exposed to the risk of loss than a fund that invests more broadly. At times, the Fund and other accounts managed by the Adviser may own all or most of the debt of a particular issuer. This concentration of ownership may make it more difficult to sell, or to determine the fair value of, these investments. In addition, a Fund may focus on a segment of the tax-exempt debt market, such as revenue bonds for health care facilities, housing or airports. These investments may cause the value of a Fund’s shares to change more than the values of shares of funds that invest more diversely. The yields on the securities in which the Funds invest generally are dependent on a variety of factors, including the financial condition of the issuer or other obligor, the revenue source from which the debt service is payable, general economic and monetary conditions, conditions in the relevant market, the size of a particular issue, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. In addition to such factors, geographically concentrated securities will experience particular sensitivity to local conditions, including political and economic changes, adverse conditions to an industry significant to the area, and other developments within a particular locality. Because many tax-exempt bonds may be revenue or general obligations of local governments or authorities, ratings on tax-exempt bonds may be different from the ratings given to the general obligation bonds of a particular state.

Certain events may adversely affect all investments within a particular market segment of the market. Examples include litigation, legislation or court decisions, concerns about pending or contemplated litigation, legislation or court decisions, or lower demand for the services or products provided by a particular market segment. Investing mostly in state-specific, tax-exempt investments makes the Funds more vulnerable to the relevant state’s economy and to factors affecting tax-exempt issuers in the state than would be true for more geographically diversified funds. These risks include, among others:

 

   

the inability or perceived inability of a government authority to collect sufficient tax or other revenues to meet its payment obligations;

 

   

natural disasters and ecological or environmental concerns;

 

   

the introduction of constitutional or statutory limits on a tax-exempt issuer’s ability to raise revenues or increase taxes;

 

   

the inability of an issuer to pay interest on or to repay principal or securities in which the funds invest during recessionary periods; and

 

   

economic or demographic factors that may cause a decrease in tax or other revenues for a government authority or for private operators of publicly financed facilities.

More information about state specific risks may be available from official state resources.

State Specific Information

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund’s investments are highly dependent on and sensitive to the general fiscal and economic stability of the State of Connecticut (“Connecticut” or the “State”), as well as the general fiscal and economic stability of Connecticut’s subdivisions, agencies, instrumentalities or authorities, which issue the securities in which the Fund invests. The following information supplements information set forth in Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund’s prospectus, constitutes only a brief summary and does not purport to be a complete description of certain state-specific considerations and is provided to investors in view of Connecticut

 

D-1


Table of Contents

Tax-Exempt Fund’s policy of concentrating its investments in securities issued by issuers of a single state. The information is based on publicly available sources and has not been independently verified by the Adviser. It is expected that the information will be updated only on an annual basis and thus may be out of date at any time that you make an investment decision to purchase or sell shares of Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund.

To the extent that any statements made below involve matters of forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates, whether or not expressly stated to be such, they are made as such and not as representations of fact or certainty, and no representation is made that any of these statements has been or will be realized. All forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates are “forward looking statements” that must be read with an abundance of caution and that may not be realized or may not occur in the future.

Connecticut

The following information relates specifically to Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund. This summary does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all relevant facts for the Fund. Although the Fund has no reason to believe that the information summarized below is not correct in all material respects, such information has not been independently verified for accuracy or thoroughness. Rather, this information has been obtained from official statements, prospectuses and other disclosure provided in connection with various securities offerings of Connecticut and local agencies in Connecticut available as of the date of this Statement of Additional Information. The Fund assumes that all such material was prepared and published in a manner consistent with current standards of disclosure. Further, estimates and projections contained in the following information should not be construed as statements of fact. They are based on assumptions that may be affected by numerous factors and there can be no assurance that such estimates and projections will be realized or achieved.

The Fund is more susceptible to factors adversely affecting issuers of Connecticut municipal securities than comparable municipal bond funds that do not focus on investments in Connecticut issuers.

Introduction. The State, together with the nation as a whole, is facing economic and fiscal challenges brought on by the current recession. These challenges for the State include fiscal year deficits and falling employment, among other issues. The State Office of Policy and Management monitors such matters and generally issues a report periodically estimating the current fiscal year deficit. The State Comptroller issues a similar report periodically. From time to time the legislature’s Office of Fiscal Analysis also issues reports covering these matters. The most current such information is described below under “State General Fund,” which should be considered together with the other information set forth herein.

The State’s current and projected fiscal and economic condition, as described herein, is subject to change based on a number of factors. Such factors include, but are not limited to: (a) developments with respect to the national economy as a whole, (b) developments with respect to the financial services sector of the economy, (c) developments in the world economy, and in particular commodity prices such as oil, (d) federal fiscal and economic policies, including fiscal stimulus efforts in general and the effect of such stimulus efforts in the State and the amount of federal aid to the State, (e) the extent to which the federal stimulus legislation, and in particular The American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (the “ARRA”), as enacted and implemented, provides less federal aid to the State than was anticipated in the adopted biennial budget, and the resulting need to implement other revenue enhancements or expenditure reductions, and (f) the effect of the State’s constitutional balanced budget requirement and spending cap provisions on the adoption of the biennial budget and the effect spending constraints might have on the State’s economy. Such factors are continually changing, and no assurances can be given with respect to how such factors or other factors will materialize in the future or what effect they will have on the State’s fiscal and economic condition.

Connecticut’s economic performance is measured by personal income, which has been among the highest in the nation, and gross state product (the market value of all final goods and services produced by labor and

 

D-2


Table of Contents

property located within the State), which demonstrated slower growth in the early 2000s, but expanded at a healthy pace in 2004, surpassing the New England and national growth rates. Since then, Connecticut’s annual growth in gross state product has performed better than the New England region, but mostly slower than the nation. Employment had gained approximately 66,800 jobs by late 2007 since it bottomed out in July of 2003, but in 2008 Connecticut lost jobs.

After enjoying an extraordinary boom during the late 1990s, Connecticut, as well as the rest of the northeast and the nation, experienced an economic slowdown during the recession of the early 2000s. The unemployment rate in the State reached its low of 2.3% in 2000, compared to New England’s average of 2.8% and the national average of 4.0%. After climbing to a high of 5.5% in 2003, Connecticut’s unemployment rate declined to 4.4% for 2006. The current recession brought the unemployment rate up to 5.1% for the first six months of 2008, compared to the New England average of 4.8% and the national average of 5.1% for the same period.

General Fund. The State finances most of its operations through its General Fund. However, certain State functions, such as the State’s transportation budget, are financed through other State funds. General Fund revenues are derived primarily from the collection of State taxes, including the personal income tax, the sales and use tax and the corporation business tax. Miscellaneous fees, receipts, transfers and unrestricted federal grants account for most of the other General Fund revenue. The State, as of the forecast date, expected to derive approximately 76 percent and 72 percent, respectively, of its General Fund revenues from taxes during the 2007-08 fiscal year and the 2008-09 fiscal year.

Budget for Fiscal Years 2007-2008 and 2008-2009. Although the General Assembly did not pass the biennial budget for fiscal years 2007-08 and 2008-09 prior to its adjournment date of June 6, 2007, in a subsequent special session, the General Assembly passed, and the Governor signed into law on June 26, 2007, the biennial budget for fiscal years 2007-08 and 2008-09. The budget for fiscal year 2007-08 included General Fund revenues of $16,315.6 million and net appropriations of $16,314.9 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.7 million The budget for fiscal year 2008-09 included General Fund revenues of $17,073.1 million and net appropriations of $17,072.3 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.8 million. Pursuant to Public Act No. 07-1 of the September Special Session of the General Assembly, the General Assembly made an additional appropriation of $0.7 million for clean contracting standards, thereby reducing the projected General Fund surplus for the 2008-09 fiscal year to $0.1 million.

The General Assembly also included in the biennial budget (i) the appropriation of $613.7 million of the anticipated fiscal year 2006-07 General Fund surplus funds to pay for various spending items, including $300 million to fund a portion of the State’s contribution to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund and $85 million for debt retirement, (ii) a reduction of lapses in the amount of $96.6 million and (iii) a transfer of $80 million of the anticipated fiscal year 2006-07 General Fund surplus to the budget for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2009, resulting in a net reduction in the anticipated 2006-07 surplus of $790.3 million. According to estimates of the Office of Fiscal Analysis, approximately $471.9 million of the appropriations were for one-time purposes and approximately $318.4 million of the appropriations were for on-going purposes.

The budget was $690.4 million above the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2007-08 and $28.2 million below the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2008-09. In accordance with the provisions of Article XXVIII of the Amendments to the Constitution, the Governor issued a declaration to exceed the State’s expenditure cap in fiscal year 2007-08. This declaration was ratified by a three-fifths vote of each house of the General Assembly.

Fiscal Year 2007-2008 Operations. Pursuant to the Comptroller’s financial statements provided on December 31, 2008, as of June 30, 2008, General Fund revenues were $16,418.8 million, General Fund expenditures and net miscellaneous adjustments were $16,319.4 million and the General Fund balance for the 2007-08 fiscal year was a surplus of $99.4 million The entire surplus was reserved for fiscal year 2008-09 spending.

 

D-3


Table of Contents

 

Governor’s Proposed Midterm Budget Adjustments. Per Section 4-71 of the Connecticut General Statutes, the Governor is required to submit a status report to the General Assembly on the biennial budget enacted in the previous year. The status report must include any recommendations for adjustments and revisions to the enacted budget.

On February 6, 2008 the Governor submitted to the General Assembly a status report including detailed projections of expenditures and revenues and proposed Midterm Budget Adjustments for the 2007-08 and 2008-09 fiscal years. The General Assembly convened on February 6, 2008 to consider the Governor’s proposed Midterm Budget Adjustments and adjourned on May 7, 2008. The legislature did not make any midterm budget adjustments for the 2008-09 fiscal year in the legislative session which ended May 7, 2008. However, in subsequent special sessions, $79 million was appropriated for energy relief programs in fiscal year 2008-09 and the 2007-08 surplus of $83.4 million, plus the transfer of $16 million pursuant to Section 91 of Public Act No. 07-1 of the June Special Session, was transferred for use in fiscal year 2008-09. In addition, the scheduled increase on July 1, 2008 in the oil companies tax from 7.0% to 7.5% was eliminated.

Fiscal Year 2008-2009 Operations. Pursuant to Section 4-66 of the Connecticut General Statutes, the Office of Policy and Management provides estimates to the Comptroller by the twentieth day of each month of revenues and expenditures for the current fiscal year for use by the Comptroller in preparing the Comptroller’s monthly report. In the monthly estimates provided by the Office of Policy and Management on August 20, 2008 (as of the period ending July 31, 2008), September 22, 2008 (as of the period ending August 31, 2008), October 20, 2008 (as of the period ending September 30, 2008), November 20, 2008 (as of the period ending October 31, 2008) and December 20, 2008 (as of the period ending November 30, 2008), each for the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year, the General Fund was estimated to have a deficit of $145.7 million, $302.4 million, $107.9 million, $356.3 million and $193.0 million, respectively. In the monthly estimate provided by the Office of Policy and Management on January 20, 2009 for the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year, as of the period ending December 31, 2008, General Fund revenues were estimated at $16,098.0 million, General Fund expenditures and miscellaneous adjustments were estimated at $17,019.7 million and the General Fund was estimated to have a deficit of $921.7 million These revenue estimates include an estimated $40 million from tax amnesty program and $12 million from the escheat of unclaimed bottler deposits and transfers totaling $71.2 million from various funds to the General Fund per Public Act No. 08-1 of the November 24, Special Session and Public Act No. 09-1. The expenditure estimates included three allotment rescissions in 2008 totaling $157 million and two mitigation plans totaling $69.8 million per Public Act No. 08-1 of the November 24, 2008 Special Session and Public Act No. 09-1. The revenue estimates as of December 31, 2008 did not take into account any economic effect as a result of the changes in the financial and credit markets occurring after December 31, 2008 or during the remainder of the fiscal year. No assurances can be given that future report estimates will match the Office of Policy and Management’s prior estimates.

By statute, the State’s fiscal position is reported monthly by the Comptroller. In her monthly reports dated September 2, 2008, October 1, 2008 and November 3, 2008, the Comptroller generally agreed with the Office of Policy and Management’s projections as of the periods ending July 31, 2008, August 31, 2008 and September 30, 2008, respectively. In her monthly report dated December 1, 2008, the Comptroller’s estimate of the General Fund deficit for the 2008-09 fiscal year was $50 million higher than the Office of Policy and Management’s projection for the same period. In her monthly report dated January 2, 2009, the Comptroller’s estimate of the General Fund deficit for the 2008-09 fiscal year was $150 million higher than the Office of Policy and Management’s projections for the same period. In her monthly report dated February 2, 2009 for the period ending December 31, 2008, the Comptroller’s estimate of the General Fund deficit for the 2008-09 fiscal year was $1.1 billion, which amount was $172.9 million higher than the estimate of the Office of Policy and Management.

Pursuant to Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes, whenever the cumulative monthly financial statement issued by the Comptroller indicates a projected General Fund deficit greater than one percent of the total General Fund appropriations, the Governor is required within thirty days to file a report with the joint

 

D-4


Table of Contents

standing committees of the General Assembly on appropriations and on finance, revenue and bonding. The report must include a plan which the Governor must implement to modify agency allotments to the extent necessary to prevent a deficit. Should such plan result in a reduction of more than five percent of total appropriations, approval of the General Assembly would be required. Since July 2008, the Governor has exercised her authority under Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes in rescinding allotments totaling $157 million in General Fund expenditures. In addition, the Governor has proposed two deficit mitigation packages to address the then projected deficits that exceeded her allotment rescission authority. Public Act No. 08-1 of the November 24, 2008 Special Session and Public Act No. 09-1 were enacted by the General Assembly and resulted in an estimated $193.6 million in deficit mitigation. Even with these changes, on January 20, 2009, the Office of Policy and Management projected a $921.7 million deficit in the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year.

The above projections are only estimates and the information in the monthly letters of the Office of Policy and Management to the Comptroller and in the Comptroller’s monthly reports contain only estimates and no assurances can be given that future events will materialize as estimated or that subsequent estimates, adjustments or audit or actions of the General Assembly will not indicate changes in the final result of the fiscal year 2008-09 operations of the General Fund.

Pursuant to the Comptroller’s unaudited preliminary financial results dated September 1, 2009, the Comptroller estimated the General Fund revenues for the 2008-09 fiscal year were $15,700.8 million, General Fund expenditures and miscellaneous adjustments were $16,626.7 million and the General Fund balance for the 2008-09 fiscal year was estimated to have a deficit of $925.9 million. The Comptroller indicated in her letter that under House Bill No. 6802, the General Assembly approved additional carry forward authority which is accounted for as part of the 2008-09 fiscal year deficit and therefore increases the deficit. Accordingly, the 2008-09 fiscal year deficit would increase to $947.6 million upon the act becoming law. House Bill No. 6802 became law after the date of the Comptroller’s September 1, 2009 results. Pursuant to Public Act No. 09-2 of the June Special Session, for the purpose of funding the deficit in the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year, the Treasurer is authorized to issue notes of the State in an amount not to exceed the amount of such deficit and in such additional amounts as the Treasurer shall determine to pay the costs of issuance of any such notes and interest payable or accrued on such notes through June 30, 2011.

The above projections are only estimates and the information in the Comptroller’s report contains only estimates and no assurances can be given that future events will materialize as estimated or that subsequent estimates, adjustments or audit or actions of the General Assembly will not indicate changes in the final result of the fiscal year 2008-09 operations of the General Fund.

Budget for Fiscal Years 2009-2010 and 2010-2011. On June 3, 2009, the General Assembly adjourned its regular 2009 session without adopting a fiscal 2009-2011 biennial budget. Prior to adjournment, the General Assembly passed resolutions calling for a special session to take up matters related to adoption of a budget. The special session was immediately convened at the conclusion of the regular session. During the special session, the General Assembly passed a General Fund budget for the 2009-10 and 2010-11 fiscal years which was subsequently vetoed by the Governor.

The State continued to run its operations pursuant to executive orders issued by the Governor. Authorization to pay debt service on the State’s general obligation bonds remained unaffected. The executive orders directed all department heads and executive branch employees to limit purchases of goods and services and directed all department heads to utilize personnel and other resources in an effective and efficient manner, giving priority to programs that provide direct care services, administer justice and protect the public health and safety. The executive orders covered the months of July, August and the portion of September until the approval of an appropriation act for the fiscal year commencing July 1, 2009.

In a special session, the General Assembly passed the biennial budget for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 which subsequently became law on September 8, 2009. The enacted budget, Public Act No. 09-3 of June 2009

 

D-5


Table of Contents

Special Session, for fiscal year 2009-10 included General Fund revenues of $17,375.4 million and net appropriations of $17,374.6 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.8 million. The budget for fiscal year 2010-11 included General Fund revenues of $17,591.9 million and net appropriations of $17,591.0 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.9 million.

The enacted biennial budget raises net revenues from three major resources: 1) grants from the ARRA, 2) transfers from other State funds to the State’s General Fund and securitizations, and 3) net increases in taxes and miscellaneous fees. Federal grants from the ARRA for human services, education, and other economic related stimulus programs total $878.9 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $594.8 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Major revenues from transfers of other State funds to the State’s General Fund and securitizations include (i) transferring Budget Reserve Funds of $1,039.7 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $342.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and (ii) securitizing $1,290.7 million in fiscal year 2010-11 as amended by Public Act No. 09-7 of the September 2009 Special Session. The significant tax changes include: (i) an increase in the highest income tax rate to 6.5% from 5% for those with taxable incomes over $1 million for joint filers, $800,000 for heads of households, and $500,000 for single filers and married people filing separately, raising approximately $594.0 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $400.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11; (ii) an imposition of a 10% corporation tax surcharge for the 2009, 2010, and 2011 income years on companies that have (1) $100 million or more in annual gross income in those years and (2) tax liability that exceeds the $250 minimum, raising approximately $74.1 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $41.1 million in fiscal year 2010-11; (iii) an increase in the cigarette tax rate from $2.00 per pack to $3.00 per pack, raising approximately $94.9 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $112.4 million in fiscal year 2010-11; (iv) changes in various fees, raising approximately a net total of $108.5 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $105.9 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and (v) cuts in taxes, including (1) a reduction in the sales and use tax rate to 5.5% from 6%, and (2) a reduction in the estate and gift tax. The reduction of the sales and use tax rate effective January 1, 2010 is expected to result in a revenue loss of approximately $129.5 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $268.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11. However, if any cumulative monthly financial statement issued by the Comptroller before January 1, 2010 indicated that the estimated gross tax revenue to the General Fund to the end of the fiscal year ending June 30, 2010 was at least 1% less than the adopted gross tax revenue to the General Fund for fiscal year 2009-10, the tax rate will remain at 6%. If any cumulative monthly financial statement issued after January 1, 2010, and on or before June 30, 2010, indicates that the estimated gross tax revenue to the General Fund to the end of the fiscal year ending June 30, 2010 is at least 1% less than the adopted gross tax revenue to the General Fund, the tax rate will remain at 6%. On the estate and gift taxes, the enacted law will (i) increase the threshold for the value of an estate or gift subject to the estate and gift taxes from $2 million to $3.5 million; (ii) reduce the marginal tax rates by 25%; and (iii) eliminate the tax cliff. These three measures were estimated to reduce revenues by approximately $5.9 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $70.3 million in fiscal year 2010-11.

The significant changes in appropriations are from State employee personal services reductions, entitlement programs savings, and education grants reductions. Personal services reductions from concessions with a coalition of employee collective bargaining units including wage freezes and a Retirement Incentive Plan are expected to save approximately $191.0 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $193.7 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Savings from entitlement programs include (i) eliminating nursing home rate increases in reimbursement levels under Medicaid, saving approximately $113.2 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $162.2 million in fiscal year 2010-11, (ii) reducing managed care organization capitation rates by 6% under both HUSKY A and HUSKY B, saving approximately $50.1 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $51.8 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and (iii) managing services for aged, blind and disabled individuals who are currently receiving care under the Medicaid fee-for-service program, saving approximately $27.8 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $80.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Education reductions include cuts of grants to (i) the Excess Cost program that reimburses funds to towns, saving approximately $13.4 million each for both fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11, (ii) the Priority School District program that assists the neediest communities and funds the School Readiness program, reducing $6.9 million each for both fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11, and (iii) the Reading Success program designed to improve kindergarten through grade three reading, saving the State $2.4 million each for both fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11.

 

D-6


Table of Contents

 

In addition, the budget for fiscal year 2010-11 requires the Treasurer and the Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management to jointly develop a financing plan that will result in net proceeds of up to $1,290.7 million to be used as general revenues of the State during such fiscal year, which may include securitizations as discussed above. The budget also requires the Treasurer and the Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management to jointly develop a plan to sell assets of the State that will result in net proceeds of up to $15 million to be used as general revenues of the State during the 2009-10 fiscal year and $45 million to be used as general revenues of the State during the 2010-11 fiscal year. In addition, the budget for fiscal year 2009-10 requires a reduction of $473.3 million in expenses from budgeted amounts. The budget for fiscal year 2010-11 requires a reduction of $515.2 million of expenses from budgeted amounts.

The budget was $852.4 million below the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2009-10 and $587.0 million below the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2010-11.

Fiscal Year 2009-2010 Operations. Pursuant to Section 4-66 of the Connecticut General Statutes, the Office of Policy and Management provides estimates to the Comptroller by the twentieth day of each month of revenues and expenditures for the current fiscal year for use by the Comptroller in preparing the Comptroller’s monthly report. In the monthly estimates provided by the Office of Policy and Management on October 20, 2009 for the General Fund for the 2009-10 fiscal year, as of the period ending September 30, 2009, General Fund revenues were estimated at $17,203.3 million, General Fund expenditures and miscellaneous adjustments were estimated at $17,591.8 million and the General Fund was estimated to have a deficit of $388.5 million. No assurances can be given that future report estimates will match the Office of Policy and Management’s prior estimates.

By statute, the State’s fiscal position is reported monthly by the Comptroller. In her monthly report dated October 1, 2009 for the period ending August 31, 2009, the Comptroller indicated that although many of the revenue enhancements associated with the budget had not yet appeared within the revenue collection figures, the first quarter revenue trends raised concerns. She indicated that if the first quarter trends continued unabated, even after fully incorporating the projected revenue gains enacted as part of the budget, the revenue shortfall in the General Fund for the 2009-10 fiscal year would exceed $500 million. She further indicated that because it was early in the fiscal year, there was sufficient time for a reversal in the trend to mitigate the shortfall. The Comptroller did not address any increased expenditures, which the Office of Policy and Management projected to be an additional $212.5 million in its October 20, 2009 report. In the Comptroller’s monthly report dated November 1, 2009, the Comptroller estimated a General Fund deficit for the 2009-10 fiscal year of $624 million as of the period ending September 30, 2009. No assurances can be given that future report estimates will match the Office of Policy and Management’s estimates or the Comptroller’s prior estimates.

The Governor may generally reduce budget allotment requests within certain prescribed limits and has done so for the current fiscal year. Additionally, as described above, pursuant to Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes, whenever the cumulative monthly financial statement issued by the Comptroller indicates a projected General Fund deficit greater than one percent of the total General Fund appropriations, the Governor is required within thirty days to file a report with the joint standing committees of the General Assembly on appropriations and on finance, revenue and bonding. The report must include a plan which the Governor must implement to modify agency allotments to the extent necessary to prevent a deficit. The Governor is required to file such report as a result of the deficit projection included in the Comptroller’s November 1, 2009 report.

The above projections are only estimates and the information in the monthly letters of the Office of Policy and Management to the Comptroller and in the Comptroller’s monthly reports contain only estimates and no assurances can be given that future events will materialize as estimated or that subsequent estimates, adjustments or audit or actions of the General Assembly will not indicate changes in the final result of the fiscal year 2009-10 operations of the General Fund.

 

D-7


Table of Contents

 

STATE DEBT

Types of State Debt. Pursuant to various public and special acts the State has authorized a variety of types of debt. These types fall generally into the following categories: direct general obligation debt, which is payable from the State’s General Fund; special tax obligation debt, which is payable from specified taxes and other funds which are maintained outside the State’s General Fund; and special obligation and revenue debt, which is payable from specified revenues or other funds which are maintained outside the State’s General Fund. In addition, the State has a number of programs under which the State provides annual appropriation support for, or is contingently liable on, the debt of certain State quasi-public agencies and political subdivisions.

State Direct General Obligation Debt. Statutory Authorization and Security Provisions. In general, the State issues general obligation bonds pursuant to specific statutory bond acts and Section 3-20 of the General Statutes, the State general obligation bond procedure act. That act provides that such bonds shall be general obligations of the State and that the full faith and credit of the State of Connecticut are pledged for the payment of the principal of and interest on such bonds as the same become due. Such act further provides that, as a part of the contract of the State with the owners of such bonds, appropriation of all amounts necessary for the punctual payment of such principal and interest will be made, and the Treasurer will pay such principal and interest as the same become due.

There are no State constitutional provisions precluding the exercise of State power by statute to impose any taxes, including taxes on taxable property in the State or on income, in order to pay debt service on bonded debt now or hereafter incurred. The constitutional limit on increases in General Fund expenditures for any fiscal year does not include expenditures for the payment of bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness. There are also no constitutional or statutory provisions requiring or precluding the enactment of liens on or pledges of State General Fund revenues or taxes, or the establishment of priorities for payment of debt service on the State’s general obligation bonds. There are no express statutory provisions establishing any priorities in favor of general obligation bondholders over other valid claims against the State.

Statutory Debt Limit. Section 3-21 of the General Statutes provides that no bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness for borrowed money payable from General Fund tax receipts of the State may be authorized by the General Assembly or issued unless they do not cause the aggregate amount of (1) the total amount of bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness payable from General Fund tax receipts authorized by the General Assembly but which have not been issued and (2) the total amount of such indebtedness which has been issued and remains outstanding, to exceed 1.6 times the total estimated General Fund tax receipts of the State for the fiscal year in which any such authorization will become effective or in which such indebtedness is issued, as estimated for such fiscal year by the joint standing committee of the General Assembly having cognizance of finance, revenue and bonding. However, in computing the aggregate amount of indebtedness at any time, revenue anticipation notes having a maturity of one year or less, refunded indebtedness, bond anticipation notes, borrowings payable solely from the revenues of a particular project, the balances of debt retirement funds associated with indebtedness subject to the debt limit as certified by the Treasurer, the amount of federal grants certified by the Secretary of OPM as receivable to meet the principal of certain indebtedness, all authorized and issued indebtedness to fund any budget deficits of the State for any fiscal year ending on or before June 30, 1991 and for the fiscal years ending June 30, 2002 and June 30, 2003, all authorized debt to fund the Connecticut Development Authority’s tax increment bond program, any indebtedness represented by agreements entered into pursuant to certain provisions of the General Statutes, provided the indebtedness in connection with which such agreements were entered into shall be included in such aggregate amount of indebtedness, any indebtedness issued for the purpose of meeting cash flow needs, and any indebtedness issued for the purpose of covering emergency needs in times of natural disaster are excluded or deducted. For purposes of the debt limit statute, all bonds and notes issued or guaranteed by the State and payable from General Fund tax receipts are counted against the limit, except for the exclusions or deductions described above. In addition, the amount of authorized but unissued debt for the UConn 2000 program is limited to the amount permitted to be issued under the cap.

 

D-8


Table of Contents

 

Under the General Statutes, the Treasurer is required to compute the aggregate amount of indebtedness as of January 1 and July 1 each year and to certify the results of such computation to the Governor and the General Assembly. If the aggregate amount of indebtedness reaches 90% of the statutory debt limit, the Governor must review each bond act for which no bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness have been issued, and recommend to the General Assembly priorities for repealing authorizations for remaining projects.

Certain Short-Term Borrowings. The General Statutes authorize the Treasurer, subject to the approval of the Governor, to borrow such funds, from time to time, as may be necessary, and to issue obligations of the State therefor, which must be redeemed by the Treasurer whenever, in the opinion of the Treasurer, there are funds in the treasury available for such purpose. The State has established programs of temporary note issuances from time to time to cover periodic cash flow requirements. On June 18, 2009, pursuant to the Treasurer’s request and the Governor’s approval to borrow funds on a temporary basis from time to time on behalf of the State, the Treasurer arranged with a group of banks a 364-day revolving credit facility in the amount of $580 million.

OTHER FUNDS, DEBT AND LIABILITIES

The State conducts certain of its operations through State funds other than the State General Fund and, pursuant to legislation, may issue debt secured by the special taxes or revenues pledged to certain of such funds. In addition, the State is contingently liable or has limited liability, from the resources of the State’s General Fund, for payment of debt service on certain obligations of quasi-public State agencies and municipalities of the State. The State has also made commitments to municipalities to make future grant payments for school construction projects, payable over a period of years. In addition, the State has committed to apply moneys for debt service on loans to finance child care facilities and has certain other contingent liabilities for future payments.

Transportation Fund and Debt. In 1984 the State adopted legislation establishing a transportation infrastructure program and authorizing special tax obligation (“STO”) bonds to finance the program. The infrastructure program is a continuous program for planning, construction and improvement of State highways and bridges, projects on the interstate highway system, alternate highway projects in the interstate highway substitution program, waterway facilities, mass transportation and transit facilities, aeronautic facilities (excluding Bradley International Airport), the highway safety program, maintenance garages and administrative facilities of the Department of Transportation, payment of the State’s share of the costs of the local bridge program established under the act, and payment of State contributions to the local bridge revolving fund established under the act. The infrastructure program is administered by the Department of Transportation.

The cost of the infrastructure program for State fiscal years 1985-2012, which will be met from federal, State and local funds, is currently estimated at $23.5 billion. The State’s share of such cost, estimated at $9.5 billion, is to be funded from transportation related taxes, fees and revenues deposited in the Special Transportation Fund, as described below, and from the proceeds of STO bonds. The portion of State program costs not financed by STO bonds is estimated at $0.6 billion and includes the expenses of the infrastructure program that either are not sufficiently large or do not have a sufficiently long life expectancy to justify the issuance of long-term bonds. Such expenses currently include liquid resurfacing, minor bridge repairs, highway maintenance activities, safety improvements and other minor transportation improvements.

The State’s share of the cost of the Infrastructure Program for State fiscal years 1985-2012 to be financed by STO bonds currently is estimated at $8.9 billion. The actual amount may exceed $8.9 billion to finance reserves and cost of issuance amounts. The issuance of such STO bonds has eliminated the need for the authorization of additional general obligation bonds of the State for surface transportation purposes. STO bonds may also be issued for the purpose of refunding general obligation bonds of the State issued for transportation infrastructure purposes.

 

D-9


Table of Contents

 

During fiscal years 1985-2007, $18.3 billion of the total infrastructure program was approved by the appropriate governmental authorities. The remaining $5.2 billion is required for fiscal years 2008-2012. The $5.2 billion of such infrastructure costs is anticipated to be funded with proceeds of $1.8 billion from the anticipated issuance of new STO bonds, $63 million in anticipated revenues, and $3.3 billion in anticipated federal funds.

The State has established the Special Transportation Fund for the purpose of budgeting and accounting for all transportation related taxes, fees and revenues credited to such Fund and securing the STO bonds. STO bonds are payable solely from revenues of the Special Transportation Fund. The aggregate of certain motor fuel taxes, motor vehicle receipts, motor vehicle related licenses, permits and fees, and portions of the oil companies tax and sales tax on motor vehicles and other transportation related revenue sources, including enacted adjustments to all the foregoing sources, are intended to cover the cost of the State’s share of the infrastructure program, including debt service requirements. After providing for debt service requirements, the balance of the receipts from such revenue sources may be applied to the payment of general obligation bonds of the State issued for transportation purposes and for the payment of annually budgeted expenses of the Department of Transportation and the Department of Motor Vehicles.

It is anticipated that additional STO bonds will be authorized by the General Assembly annually in an amount necessary to finance and to complete the infrastructure program. Such additional bonds may be issued on an equal rank with the outstanding bonds provided certain pledged revenue coverage requirements of the STO indentures controlling the issuance of such bonds are met. The State expects to continue to offer bonds for this program.

In addition to STO Bonds, the State has issued direct general obligation bonds for transportation purposes and the debt service on these bonds may be paid from resources of the Special Transportation Fund provided there is sufficient funding first to pay all STO debt service. For the year ended June 30, 2008 the Special Transportation Fund paid $3.1 million of State direct general obligation transportation debt service payments. The amount budgeted by the Special Transportation Fund for State direct general obligation transportation debt service payments for fiscal year 2008-09 was $2.0 million

During the past several years the Fund’s revenues and expenses have undergone a variety of legislative changes. In 2003 legislation provided for a one-time transfer of $52 million from the Fund to the State’s General Fund. In 2004 legislation increased the tax on gasohol and raised various motor vehicle fees resulting in an $18.6 million benefit to the Fund. In 2005 legislation increased the scheduled transfers to the Fund from the State’s General Fund from Oil Companies Tax revenue by $22.5 million in fiscal year 2006, $30 million in fiscal year 2007, $53 million in fiscal year 2008, $79.9 million in each of fiscal years 2009-2013, and $98 million thereafter. In 2006, legislation again increased the scheduled transfers to the Fund from the State’s General Fund from Oil Companies Tax revenue by $80 million in each of fiscal years 2007-2010 and by $100 million in fiscal year 2011 and thereafter. In July 2007 legislation increased the motor fuels tax on each gallon of diesel fuel from $0.26 to $0.37 and correspondingly exempted diesel fuel from the petroleum products gross earnings tax.

A fifteen member Transportation Strategy Board (“TSB”) was established in 2001 to propose a transportation strategy, an implementation cost estimate and funding approaches to the Governor and General Assembly. The TSB’s strategic goals are: 1) improve personal mobility within and through Connecticut; 2) improve the movement of goods and freight within and through Connecticut; 3) integrate transportation with economic, land use, environmental and quality of life issues; 4) develop policies and procedures that will integrate the state economy with regional, national and global economies; and 5) identify policies and sources that provide an adequate and reliable flow of funding necessary for a quality multi-modal transportation system. The TSB presented the initial transportation strategy to the Governor and General Assembly on January 6, 2003. In January 2007, as required in Public Act No. 06-136, the TSB again presented “Connecticut’s Transportation Strategy” to the Governor and General Assembly.

 

D-10


Table of Contents

 

In order to implement the strategy-related projects submitted by TSB, legislation was passed in 2005 that established fixed transfers from the Special Transportation Fund to the TSB project accounts in the amounts of $25.3 million in fiscal year 2005-06, $20.3 million in fiscal year 2006-07, $15.3 million in each of fiscal years 2007-08 through 2014-15 and $0.3 million in fiscal year 2015-16 and thereafter. In September 2007 legislation authorized the transfer of $5.5 million on deposit in the Special Transportation Fund to the TSB’s project account for various transportation related studies.

Public Acts in 2005 and 2006 authorized the issuance of more than $2.1 billion of special tax obligation bonds for the ten-year period from 2005 to 2014 for transportation system improvements, many of which are TSB-recommended projects. As of February 1, 2009 $2.0 billion of the borrowing authorized is effective with the remaining $100 million becoming effective in fiscal year 2009-10. Legislation passed in 2006 also authorized the issuance of $1.3 billion in bonds in anticipation of future federal transportation funds. Pursuant to Public Act No. 09-2 of the September 2009 Special Session, the General Assembly has authorized special tax obligation bonds of $579.2 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $265.4 million in fiscal year 2010-11. In November 2009, the State issued $195,970,000 Special Tax Obligation Bonds Transportation Infrastructure Purposes, 2009 Series A, $304,030,000 Special Tax Obligation Bonds Transportation Infrastructure Purposes, 2009 Series B (Taxable Build America Bonds—Direct Pay), and $49,775,000 Special Tax Obligation Refunding Bonds Transportation Infrastructure Purposes, 2009 Series C.

Other Special Revenue Funds and Debt

Bradley Airport. Bradley International Airport, located in Windsor Locks, Connecticut, is owned by the State and operated by the Bureau of Aviation and Ports in the State’s Department of Transportation. The General Assembly has authorized the issuance of revenue bonds for improvements at Bradley International Airport, payable from all or a portion of the revenues generated at the airport. Legislation passed in 2001 removed a $294 million bond issuance cap for Bradley Airport but retained the requirement for State Bond Commission approval of any new bond issue. As of February 1, 2009, there were $198.9 million of Bradley International Airport Revenue Bonds outstanding.

The 2001 legislation also established a board of directors to oversee the operation and development of Bradley Airport. The seven-member board includes five appointed members and the Commissioners of Transportation and Economic and Community Development. The Bradley board is charged with a wide range of duties and responsibilities, including developing an organizational and management structure, approving the annual capital and operating budget, master plan, and community relations policies of the airport, and ensuring customer service standards and performance assessments.

Additional special obligation bonds to finance self-sustaining special facilities at Bradley International Airport payable solely from the revenues derived from such special facilities were authorized in 1993. In March 2000 the State issued $53.8 million of Bradley International Airport Special Obligation Parking Revenue Bonds to finance the construction of a five story parking garage facility at the airport and, as of February 1, 2009, $44.7 million of such bonds were outstanding.

The board of directors of Bradley Airport and the State Bond Commission approved a transaction authorizing the State Treasurer to refund Bradley International Airport General Airport Revenue Bonds, Series 2001A (AMT) for expected delivery in 2011 or thereafter and to enter into a forward starting interest rate swap transaction for the purpose of locking in current market savings. Pursuant to such authorization the State entered into certain swap agreements in April 2006.

Clean Water Fund. The General Assembly has authorized the issue of up to $1,753.4 million of revenue bonds, of which $1,209.28 million have been issued, for the purpose of funding various State and federally mandated water pollution control and drinking water projects. The revenue bonds are payable solely from the revenues or other receipts, funds or moneys pledged therefor. The proceeds of the revenue bonds are loaned

 

D-11


Table of Contents

primarily to Connecticut municipalities to finance water pollution control and drinking water improvements, and the loan repayments by the municipalities secure the bonds. The loans are evidenced by interim funding obligations and project loan obligations of the municipalities, pursuant to which either the full faith and credit of each such municipality is pledged, or the revenues and other funds of a municipal sewer system are pledged. The General Assembly has authorized the issue of up to $1,833.4 million of revenue bonds, of which $1,408.7 million has been issued, for the purpose of funding various State and federally mandated water pollution control and drinking water projects. As of October 1, 2009 $853.9 million of revenue bonds were outstanding (including refunding bonds).

Unemployment Compensation. The State pays unemployment compensation benefits from the State’s Unemployment Compensation Fund, which is funded by unemployment compensation taxes collected from employers. In 1993, the State responded to a deficit in the Fund by, among other things, issuing three series of special obligation bonds totaling $1,020.7 million to repay certain federal borrowings and to fund certain reserves. All of these bonds were defeased in June 2001. To fund future shortfalls, the State has reserved the authority to issue bonds in an aggregate amount outstanding at any time not in excess of $1,000 million, plus amounts for certain reserves and costs of issuance. The State has not incurred any additional borrowing since 1993 other than borrowings from the Federal Unemployment Trust Fund for cash flow purposes, which have been repaid prior to September 30 in each case and which therefore have not been subject to federal interest charges.

Second Injury Fund. The Second Injury Fund is a State-run workers’ compensation insurance fund which pays lost wages and medical benefits to qualified injured workers. The State established the Second Injury Fund in 1945 to encourage the hiring of persons with pre-existing physical impairments, such as veterans, and to provide relief to employers when an injured worker, who already had a pre-existing injury or condition, was hurt on the job and the second injury was made worse by the existence of the first injury. In 1995 and 1996, the State enacted legislation to close the Second Injury Fund to future second injury claims. Those laws authorized the issuance of an amount not to exceed $750 million in revenue bonds and notes outstanding at any one time to provide funds for paying past claims. No bonds are currently outstanding. The State’s management objective is to pay additional claims and settlements from current income and, if necessary, short term borrowings.

Rate Reduction Bonds. The General Assembly authorized the issuance of special obligation bonds to sustain funding of the conservation and load management and the renewable energy investment programs established under the general statutes. The State issued $205.3 million of Special Obligation Rate Reduction Bonds (2004 Series A) in June 2004. These bonds were defeased on June 5, 2008. The bonds were secured by certain revenues collected through a non-bypassable charge imposed upon each customer of the electric utilities within the State. Such revenues are property of the State and are pledged towards payment of debt service on the bonds and related costs, which pledge is a first priority lien on such revenues. The net proceeds of the bonds were deposited in the General Fund.

Contingent Liability Debt. The General Assembly has the power to impose limited or contingent liabilities upon the State in such a manner as it may deem appropriate and as may serve a public purpose. This power has been used to support the efforts of quasi-public agencies, municipalities and other authorities formed to carry out essential public and governmental functions by authorizing these entities to issue indebtedness backed, partially or fully, by General Fund resources of the State. Not all entities that are authorized to issue such indebtedness have done so, and the description below of the State’s limited or contingent liability is restricted only to specific indebtedness backed by the State.

Special Capital Reserve Funds. The primary vehicle through which the State has undertaken contingent or limited liability is the special capital reserve fund. A special capital reserve fund, if established, provides additional security for bonds issued by the entity authorized to establish such a reserve fund. Subject to exceptions in the legislation authorizing the establishment of a particular special capital reserve fund, monies held in and credited to a special capital reserve fund are intended to be used solely for the payment of the

 

D-12


Table of Contents

principal of bonds secured by such special capital reserve fund, the purchase of such bonds, the payment of interest on such bonds or the payment of any redemption premium required to be paid when such bonds are redeemed prior to maturity. The special capital reserve fund is frequently funded with bond proceeds to a specified amount (the minimum of which is often the maximum annual principal and interest payments due on the bonds). The State undertakes the obligation to restore a special capital reserve fund to its minimum level. The method for determining such required minimum capital reserve is set out in the legislation authorizing the special capital reserve fund. If the special capital reserve fund should fall below the required minimum capital reserve amount, an official of the authority or municipality which established the special capital reserve fund must certify to the Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management or the State Treasurer or both the amount necessary to restore such special capital reserve fund to the required minimum capital reserve amount. On or before December 1, annually, the amount specified in the certificate is deemed to be appropriated from the State’s General Fund and must be allotted and paid to the entity that established the special capital reserve fund. On an annual basis, the State’s liability under any special capital reserve fund mechanism is limited to its obligation to restore that fund to its minimum capital reserve amount.

Quasi-Public Agencies. The State has established by legislation several quasi-public agencies. These quasi-public agencies are not departments, institutions or agencies of the State. They are, however, bodies politic and corporate that constitute public instrumentalities and political subdivisions of the State and whose exercise of authority granted to them is deemed to be the performance of an essential public and governmental function. These organizations provide a wide range of services that might otherwise be provided directly by the State. Among the public authorities are: the Connecticut Development Authority, the Connecticut Health and Educational Facilities Authority, the Connecticut Higher Education Supplemental Loan Authority, the Connecticut Housing Finance Authority, the Connecticut Resources Recovery Authority and the Capital City Economic Development Authority. Each of these public authorities is authorized to issue bonds in its own name to facilitate its activities and each has issued bonds secured by a special capital reserve fund, or other contractual arrangement, for which the State has limited contingent liability.

Assistance to Municipalities. In addition to the limited or contingent liabilities that the State has undertaken in connection with the activities of its quasi-public agencies, the State has undertaken certain limited or contingent liabilities to assist municipalities. The State currently has limited or contingent liabilities outstanding in connection with bonds or other obligations issued by the City of Waterbury and the Southeastern Connecticut Water Authority. The State previously was obligated pursuant to the establishment of a special capital reserve fund to secure certain bonds issued by the City of Bridgeport to fund its past budget deficits; however such bonds were refunded by the city in 1996. The State previously had guaranteed debt service on bonds of the City of West Haven, but an irrevocable escrow has been established to pay such bonds. Legislation also authorized distressed municipalities, in certain circumstances and subject to various conditions, to issue deficit funding obligations secured by a special capital reserve fund. There are no such obligations currently outstanding.

School Construction Grant Commitments. The State is obligated to various cities, towns and regional school districts under a grant-in-aid public school building program to fund certain of the costs of construction and alteration of school buildings or to support part of the debt service payments on municipal debt issued to fund the State’s share of such school building projects. For certain school projects approved by the General Assembly, cities, towns and districts are ranked according to their adjusted equalized net grand list per capita and based on such rankings a percentage is assigned which determines the amount of grant money a town or regional school district is eligible to receive for a project or type of project authorized by the legislature and approved by the Commissioner of Education.

For school construction projects approved during the 1997 legislative session and thereafter, the State pays the costs of its share of construction projects on a progress payment basis during the construction period. Each year the legislature authorizes grant commitments which vary in amounts from year to year. The State has authorized new school construction grant commitments of approximately $400 million which take effect in the 2009-10 fiscal year. As of June 30, 2009, the Commissioner estimates that current grant obligations under the

 

D-13


Table of Contents

grant program established in 1997 are approximately $2,450 million, which includes approximately $6,900 million of grants approved as of such date less payments already made of $4,450 million.

Prior to 1997 the grant program was conducted differently. For certain school projects grants for construction costs are paid to the cities, towns and districts in installments which correspond to the number and time of principal payments due on municipal bonds, or temporary notes renewed for a third or subsequent year, issued to finance project costs. If a project is fully paid from sources other than borrowing, such grants are paid in five annual installments. Grants in support of interest payments correspond to the number and time of such interest payments. As of June 30, 2009, under the grant program prior to 1997 the State is obligated to various cities, towns and regional school districts for approximately $314 million in aggregate principal installment payments and $57 million aggregate interest subsidies, for a total of $371 million. Funding for these payments may come from future State direct general obligation bond sales. No new grant commitment can be authorized under this program.

The legislature has authorized bonds for both grant programs based on the amount of grants that the Commissioner of Education estimates will be paid during each fiscal year. Since there is generally a lapse of one or more years from the time grant commitments are approved to the time grant payments are required to be made, the amount of unpaid grant commitments will be significantly greater than the amount of bonds authorized to fund the grant commitments.

Child Care Facilities Debt Service Commitments. Legislation enacted in 1997 authorized the Connecticut Health and Educational Facilities Authority (CHEFA) to issue bonds and loan the proceeds to various entities to finance child care facilities. The Department of Social Services may enter into commitments to apply monies for each such entity to pay the debt service on the loans in amounts sufficient to cover a portion of the debt service on CHEFA’s bonds. Legislation enacted in 1999 provided for the obligation of the Department of Social Services to make debt service payments to be made by the State Treasurer. Any obligation by the Department of Social Services or the State Treasurer to pay is subject to annual appropriation. CHEFA first issued special obligation bonds under this program in 1998. As of February 1, 2009 CHEFA had approximately $69.6 million bonds outstanding under this program with annual debt service of approximately $5.4 million, of which the Department of Social Services is committed to pay approximately $4.5 million. The remaining portion of debt service is to be paid from Department of Education and Department of Social Services intercepts of revenues from providers. Two other Child Care Facilities programs also authorize the Commissioner of the Department of Social Services to enter into guaranties of loans made to entities to finance the development of child care and child development centers or programs. CHEFA is administering this program on behalf of the Department, and is currently limiting the aggregate amount of guaranties to the balance of monies in the reserve funds for the respective programs.

Other Contingent Liabilities. The Connecticut Lottery Corporation (the “Corporation”) was created in 1996 as a public instrumentality of the State to operate the State’s lottery pursuant to the Connecticut Lottery Corporation Act (the “CLC Act”). The State and the Corporation purchase annuities under group contracts with insurance companies which provide payments corresponding to the obligation for payments to lottery prize winners. The State has transferred to the Corporation all annuities purchased by it and the Corporation has assumed responsibility for the collection of revenue generated from the lottery and for the payment of all lottery prizes. Under the CLC Act, the termination of the Corporation would not affect any outstanding contractual obligation of the Corporation and the State would succeed to the obligations of the Corporation under any such contract. As of June 30, 2008 the current and long term liabilities of the Corporation total $291 million.

PENSION AND RETIREMENT SYSTEMS

State Employees’ Retirement Fund. The State Employees’ Retirement Fund is one of the systems maintained by the State with approximately 53,196 active members, 1,592 inactive (vested) members and 38,093 retired members as of June 30, 2008. Generally, employees hired before July 1, 1984 participate in the Tier I plan, which includes employee contributions. As of July 1, 2008 approximately 13% of the total work force was

 

D-14


Table of Contents

covered under the Tier I Plan. Other employees generally participate in the Tier II plan, which is non-contributory and provides somewhat lesser benefits. As of July 1, 2008, approximately 42% of the total workforce was covered under the Tier II plan. Employees hired after July 1, 1997 participate in the Tier IIA plan, which requires contributions from its employee members. As of July 1, 2008, approximately 45% of the total work force was covered under the Tier IIA Plan. Since fiscal year 1978-79, payments into the State Employees’ Retirement Fund and investment income in each fiscal year, with the exception of fiscal year 2003-04, have been sufficient to meet benefits paid from the fund in such year. Payments into the fund are made from employee contributions, General and Special Transportation Fund appropriations and grant reimbursements from Federal and other funds. State contributions to the fund are made monthly on the basis of transfers submitted by the Office of the State Comptroller.

Full actuarial valuations are performed as of June 30th of each even-numbered year. The most recent actuarial valuation of November 2008 indicated that, as of June 30, 2007, the State Employees’ Retirement Fund had assets with an actuarial value of $9,585 0 million and as of June 30, 2008, the State Employees’ Retirement Fund had assets with an actuarial value of $9,990.2 million. The actuarial valuation was based upon an 8.25% earnings assumption and the effect of phasing in an approximately 4.8% negative return on plan assets for the 2007-08 fiscal year. The Treasurer has realized an annualized net return of 6.06% on investment assets in the State Employees’ Retirement Fund over the past ten years (fiscal year 1998-99 through fiscal year 2007-08) and an annualized net return of 9.43% over the past five years (fiscal year 2003-04 through fiscal year 2007-08). The November 2008 actuarial valuation indicated that as of June 30, 2008 the State Employees’ Retirement Fund had a funded ratio of 51.9% on a projected basis. As of June 30, 2008 the market value of the fund’s investment assets, as reported in the actuarial valuation, was $9,329,175,038. The market value of the fund’s investment assets is continually subject to change based on a variety of factors, including changes in the financial and credit markets and general economic conditions, and the current market value of the fund’s investment assets is lower than it was at June 30, 2008. As of June 30, 2009, the market value of the fund’s investment assets was $7,320,843,712.

The November 2008 actuarial valuation determined the following employer contribution requirements, based on a projected unit credit actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions, which contributions are sufficient to meet Governmental Accounting Standards Board (“GASB”) standards: (i) $897.4 million for fiscal year 2009-10, and (ii) $944.1 million for fiscal year 2010-11. The annual contribution requirements for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 include amounts which may be required pursuant to the Supreme Court’s decision in the case of Longley v. State Employees Retirement Commission, which requires that the plaintiffs’ final pro-rated longevity payment be included in the earnings calculations for purposes of calculating their retirement incomes. The State met 99.25% of its annual contribution requirement for fiscal year 2007-08. To meet the State’s annual contribution requirements for fiscal year 2008-09, $575.8 million was appropriated from the General Fund and the Special Transportation Fund. The Office of Policy and Management projects that contributions to the fund for fiscal year 2008-09 from grant reimbursements from federal and other funds will be sufficient to meet the balance of the required annual contribution.

Teachers’ Retirement Fund. The Teachers’ Retirement Fund, administered by the Teachers’ Retirement Board, provides benefits for any teacher, principal, supervisor, superintendent or other eligible employee in the public school systems of the State, with certain exceptions. While establishing salary schedules for teachers, municipalities do not provide contributions to the maintenance of the fund. As of June 30, 2008, there were 61,421 active and former employees with accrued and accruing benefits and 28,609 retired members.

Since fiscal year 1978-79, payments into the Teachers’ Retirement Fund and investment income in each fiscal year, with the exception of fiscal years 2003-04 and 2004-05, have been sufficient to meet benefits paid from the fund in such year. Contributions to the fund are made by employees and by General Fund appropriations from the State. State contributions to the fund are made quarterly on the basis of certifications submitted by the Teachers’ Retirement Board and are funded with annual appropriations from the General Fund.

 

D-15


Table of Contents

 

Actuarial valuations are performed as of June 30th of each even-numbered year. The most recent actuarial valuation dated November 12, 2008 indicated that, as of June 30, 2008, the Teachers’ Retirement Fund had assets, inclusive of the cost-of-living adjustment reserve account, with an actuarial value of $15,271.0 million. The actuarial valuation was based upon an 8.50% earnings assumption. The Treasurer has realized an annualized net return of 6.13% on investment assets in the Teachers’ Retirement Fund over the past ten years (fiscal year 1998-99 through fiscal year 2007-08) and an annualized net return of 9.56% over the past five years (fiscal year 2003-04 through fiscal year 2007-08). The November 2008 actuarial valuation indicated that as of June 30, 2008 the Teachers’ Retirement Fund had a funded ratio of 70.1% on a projected basis. As of June 30, 2008, the market value of the fund’s investment assets, as reported in the actuarial valuation, was $14,551,467,434. The market value of the fund’s investment assets is continually subject to change based on a variety of factors, including changes in the financial and credit markets and general economic conditions and the current market value of the fund’s investment assets is lower than it was at June 30, 2008. As of June 30, 2009, the market value of the fund’s investment assets was $11,396,681,762.

The actuarial valuation dated November 29, 2006 determined the following employer contribution requirements, based on an individual entry-age actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions, which contributions are sufficient to meet GASB standards: (i) $518.6 million for fiscal year 2007-08, and (ii) $539.3 million for fiscal year 2008-09. The State met its annual contribution requirement for fiscal year 2007-08. To meet the State’s annual contribution requirement for fiscal year 2008-09, $539.3 million has been appropriated. The actuarial valuation dated November 12, 2008 determined the following employer contribution requirements, which are sufficient to meet GASB standards: (i) $559.2 million for fiscal year 2009-10, and (ii) $581.6 million for fiscal year 2010-11.

Public Act No. 07-186 authorized the issuance of general obligation bonds (“TRF Bonds”) of the State in amounts sufficient to fund a $2.0 billion deposit to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund plus amounts required for costs of issuance and up to two years of capitalized interest. The Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management and the State Treasurer subsequently determined that issuance of such bonds would be in the best interests of the State, and in April 2008 the State issued $2,276,578,270.75 of such bonds.

Section 8 of Public Act No. 07-186 provides that, in each fiscal year that any TRF Bonds (or any refunding bonds) are outstanding, an amount equal to the annual required contribution to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund is deemed to be appropriated from the General Fund, and such amount must be deposited in the fund in such fiscal year. The amounts of the annual required contributions for each biennial budget are based on the actuarial valuation required to be completed by the December 1 prior to the beginning of the next biennial budget. Under Section 8 the State has pledged to and agreed with the holders of any TRF Bonds that, so long as the actuarial evaluation of the Teachers’ Retirement Fund is completed and the certification of the annual contribution amounts is made as required by Section 8, no public or special act of the General Assembly shall diminish such required contribution until such bonds, together with interest thereon, are fully met and discharged unless adequate provision is made by law for the protection of the holders of the bonds. Such contributions may be reduced in any biennium, however, if (i) the Governor declares an emergency or the existence of extraordinary circumstances (which may include changes in actuarial methods or accounting standards) in which the provisions of Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes is invoked, (ii) at least three-fifths of the members of each Chamber of the General Assembly vote to diminish such required contributions during the biennium for which the emergency or extraordinary circumstances are determined, and (iii) the funded ratio of the fund is at least equal to the funded ratio immediately after the sale of the bonds in accordance with the actuarial method used at the time. If such conditions are met, the funding of the annual required actuarial contribution may be diminished, but in no event may such diminution result in a reduction of the funded ratio of the fund by more than 5% from (i) the funded ratio which would otherwise have resulted had the State funded the full required contribution or (ii) the funded ratio immediately after the sale of the bonds, whichever is greater.

The statutory provisions that govern pension benefits payable from the Teachers’ Retirement Fund include certain cost of living adjustments. Public Act No. 07-186 added a provision limiting cost-of-living adjustments

 

D-16


Table of Contents

for employees hired after July 1, 2007, but also removed a statutory provision that subjected certain annual cost of living adjustments in pension benefits to a limit based on funds available from earnings on fund investments which exceeded an 11.5% return. Such excess earnings were held in the cost-of-living adjustment reserve account until applied to provide for cost of living adjustments. Although there are other statutory limits on the cost of living adjustments, it is anticipated that the removal of the limit based on available earnings that exceeded an 11.5% return will cause an increase in the aggregate actuarial accrued liability of the fund. One preliminary report estimated that these changes could increase the unfunded actuarial accrued liability by approximately $1.0 billion. This preliminary estimate was based on various assumptions and no assurances can be given that subsequent projections or the next actuarial report will not result in a higher estimate.

Other Retirement Systems. The other minor retirement systems funded by the State include the Judges, Family Support Magistrates and Compensation Commissioners Retirement System (the Judicial Retirement System), the General Assembly Pension System, the State Attorneys’ Retirement Fund and the Public Defenders’ Retirement Fund. As of June 30, 2008, there were approximately 225 active members of these plans and approximately 254 retired members. Unclassified employees of the Connecticut State System of Higher Education and the central office staff of the Department of Higher Education are eligible to participate in the Connecticut Alternate Retirement Program. This program is a defined contribution program, and thus the State has no unfunded liability with respect to the program. All member contributions and State appropriations are held in a separate retirement fund by the Treasurer who may invest and reinvest as much of the fund’s assets as are not required for current disbursements, which are composed primarily of benefit payments. Any employee who elects or has elected to participate in the program may elect to receive a refund of all contributions made by the employee into the state employees retirement system in lieu of receiving any pension benefits under said retirement system.

The State is the administrator of the Connecticut Municipal Employees’ Retirement System and the Connecticut Probate Judges and Employees’ Retirement System. As the administrator of these systems the State owes a fiduciary obligation to these systems; however, the State has no direct financial liability to pay benefits under these systems.

Social Security and Other Post-Employment Benefits. State employees, except for police and members of a retirement system other than the State Employees’ Retirement Fund, whose employment commenced after February 21, 1958 are entitled to Social Security coverage. Certain employees hired prior to that date have also elected to be covered. Pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement, state police hired on or after May 8, 1984 are entitled to Social Security coverage. As of June 30, 2008, approximately 62,828 State employees were entitled to Social Security coverage. The amount expended by the State for Social Security coverage for fiscal year 2007-08 was $298.6 million Of this amount, $221.3 million was paid from the General Fund and $14.4 million was paid from the Special Transportation Fund.

The State provides post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits to all employees who retire from State employment. The State finances the cost of such benefits on a pay-as-you-go basis; as such, the State has not established any fund for the accumulation of assets with which to pay post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits in future years. The State will need to make significant General Fund appropriations for such benefits each fiscal year. For fiscal year 2008-09 $484.2 million was appropriated.

Implementation of GASB Statement No. 45 regarding accounting and financial reporting for postemployment benefits other than pensions requires the State to obtain an analysis of the unfunded actuarial accrued liability of such post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits and to recognize the annual required contribution to fund that actuarial liability in its financial statements commencing with those for fiscal year 2007-08. The State has received an actuarial report dated March 2007 with respect to the State’s liability for post-retirement health care benefits for persons covered under the State Employees Retirement System and other State retirement systems, excluding the Teachers’ Retirement System. The report indicated an OPEB actuarial accrued liability as of April 1, 2006 estimated to range from $11.4 billion to $21.7 billion. The amounts depend

 

D-17


Table of Contents

upon various assumptions including those with respect to medical cost inflation rates, the establishment of a trust to fund those liabilities, the amount of initial and annual amounts deposited in such a trust and discount rates. The report used discount rates ranging from 4.5% to 8.5%. The amount of the annual required contribution under these various assumptions ranged from $1.0 billion to $1.6 billion for fiscal year 2006-07, based on a projected unit credit actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions. Additional assumptions were also tested for sensitivity analysis which produced different results. The annual required contribution included the cost for both current eligible employees and retirees. The State has received an interim actuarial valuation dated February 16, 2009 with respect to the State’s liability for post-retirement health care benefits for persons covered under the State Employees Retirement System and other State retirement systems, excluding the Teachers’ Retirement System, based upon the stated assumptions of the March 2007 actuarial report but reflecting actual increases in the State’s medical and dental costs between April 1, 2006 and June 30, 2008. The report indicates an OPEB actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2007 of up to $23.1 billion and a projected actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2008 of up to $24.6 billion on an unfunded basis with no valuation assets available to offset the liabilities of the plan. The interim actuarial valuation determined an employer contribution requirement for fiscal year 2007-08 of up to $1.66 billion on an unfunded basis, based on a projected unit credit actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions. The State paid $458.4 million for eligible employees and $415.4 million for retirees for health care costs in fiscal year 2006-07. The State paid $480.0 million for eligible employees and $468.8 million for retirees for health care costs in fiscal year 2007-08.

The State makes a General Fund appropriation to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund to cover one-third of retiree health insurance costs plus any portion of the balance of such costs which is not funded from the amounts available in the Teachers’ Retirement Health Insurance Fund. The amount of $24.4 million has been appropriated for such purpose for fiscal year 2008-09. Fund assets do not constitute plan assets for purposes of GASB Statements Nos. 43 and 45 and for actuarial valuation purposes fund assets are not treated as valuation assets available to offset the accrued liability of the plan. It is anticipated that significant General Fund appropriations will be required for each fiscal year to meet retiree health insurance costs. Legislation which became effective July 1, 1998 generally requires the State to subsidize the health insurance costs of retired teachers who are not members of the Teachers’ Retirement Board’s health benefit plan in a manner consistent with its prior practice of subsidizing the health insurance costs of those retired teachers who were members of the Board’s health benefit plan. Legislation which became effective July 1, 2008 generally requires the State to subsidize a portion of the health insurance costs of retired teachers who have attained normal retirement age, are ineligible to participate in Medicare Part A and pay to participate in local board of education retiree health benefit plans. Since July 1, 1994, retiree health benefits have been self-insured.

Implementation of GASB Statement No. 45 requires the State to obtain an analysis of the unfunded actuarial accrued liability of such retiree health insurance benefits and to recognize the annual required contribution to fund that actuarial liability in its financial statements commencing with those for fiscal year 2007-08. The Teachers’ Retirement Board has received an actuarial valuation of the State’s liability with respect to postretirement health care benefits for members of the Teachers’ Retirement Fund. The report indicates an actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2008 of $2,318.8 million on an unfunded basis, based upon certain stated assumptions including a 4.5% earnings assumption and a 30 year amortization period and no valuation assets available to offset the liabilities of the plan. The actuarial valuation determined a $116.7 million employer contribution requirement for fiscal year 2008-09 and $121.3 million for fiscal year 2009-10, based on an individual entry-age actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions. The State paid $20.7 million for post-retirement health insurance costs for fiscal year 2007-08. The valuation noted that if the plan were prefunded the actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2008 would be reduced to $1.52 billion based on a 7.5% earnings assumption, which would result in a $67.9 million employer contribution requirement for fiscal year 2008-09.

 

D-18


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX E — LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

Legacy Columbia funds are funds that were branded Columbia or Columbia Acorn prior to Sept. 27, 2010.

 

ColumbiaSM Acorn® Fund

ColumbiaSM Acorn International®

ColumbiaSM Acorn International Select®

ColumbiaSM Acorn Select®

ColumbiaSM Acorn USA®

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Columbia Balanced Fund

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Columbia Bond Fund

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Columbia Core Bond Fund

Columbia Corporate Income Fund (formerly known as Columbia Income Fund)

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund

Columbia Federal Securities Fund

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Global Value Fund

Columbia Greater China Fund

Columbia High Income Fund

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia International Bond Fund

Columbia International Growth Fund

Columbia International Stock Fund

Columbia International Value Fund

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Columbia Liberty Fund

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

 

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

Columbia Select Small Cap Fund

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Technology Fund

ColumbiaSM Thermostat Fund®

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia World Equity Fund

 

E-1


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX F — LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

Legacy RiverSource funds include RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds, funds renamed effective Sept. 27, 2010 to bear the Columbia brand, and certain other funds. Prior fund names are noted in parenthesis.

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund)

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund)

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Tax-Exempt Bond Fund)

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Asia Pacific Fund)

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Bond Fund)

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Equity Income Fund)

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Dividend Opportunity Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Emerging Markets Bond Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund)

Columbia Equity Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Equity Value Fund)

Columbia European Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle European Equity Fund)

Columbia Floating Rate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Floating Rate Fund)

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Frontier Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Global Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Global Bond Fund)

Columbia Global Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Global Equity Fund)

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund (RiverSource Global Extended Alpha Fund)

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc. (formerly known as RiverSource Government Money Market Fund, Inc.)

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource High Yield Bond Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Basic Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund II (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Moderate Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund III (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Enhanced Income Fund)

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Opportunities Fund)

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Inflation Protected Securities Fund)

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Equity Fund)

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Limited Duration Bond Fund)

Columbia Marsico Flexible Capital Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund)

Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Cash Management Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners International Select Value Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund)

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund)

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Recovery and Infrastructure Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2010 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2015 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2020 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2025 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2030 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2035 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2040 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2045 Fund)

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Large-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund (formerly known as Seligman Global Technology Fund)

Columbia Short-Term Cash Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund)

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Strategic Allocation Fund)

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund (formerly known as RiverSource U.S. Government Mortgage Fund)

RiverSource Balanced Fund

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

Seligman California Municipal High Yield Series

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

Seligman National Municipal Class

Seligman New York Municipal Class

Seligman TargETFund 2015

Seligman TargETFund 2025

Seligman TargETFund 2035

Seligman TargETFund 2045

Seligman TargETFund Core

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

Appendix B – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management®

 

  COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST
  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 

September 27, 2010

 

Fund

              

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class A: PHAAX

   Class B: NBASX    Class C: NAACX    Class Z: NPRAX

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NACMX

   Class B: —      Class C: —      Class Z: NCMAX

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class A: PACIX

   Class B: NCVBX    Class C: PHIKX    Class I: —  

Class Z: NCIAX

        

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NGIMX

   Class B: NGITX    Class C: NGINX    Class Z: NGAMX

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class A: NVVAX

   Class B: NGLBX    Class C: NCGLX    Class Z: NVPAX

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A: NAHAX

   Class B: NHYBX    Class C: NYICX    Class Z: NYPAX

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A: NIVLX

   Class B: NBIVX    Class C: NVICX    Class I: —  

Class R: CIVRX

   Class Z: EMIEX      

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class A: NSGAX

   Class B: NSIBX    Class C: NSGCX    Class I: —  

Class W: CLCWX

   Class Z: NSEPX      

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class A: NMIAX

   Class R: CCERX    Class I: —      Class Y: CECYX

Class Z: NMIMX

        

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A: NEIAX

   Class B: CLIBX    Class Z: NINDX   

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class A: NVLEX

   Class B: NVLNX    Class C: NVALX    Class I: —  

Class R: CVURX

   Class W: CLVWX    Class Y: CLCYX    Class Z: NVLUX

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class A: NBIAX

   Class B: NLBBX    Class C: NBICX    Class R: CLBRX

Class Z: NBGPX

        

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class A: NLGIX

   Class B: NLGBX    Class C: NLGCX    Class R: CLGRX

Class Z: NGPAX

        

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

Class A: NLGAX

   Class B: NLIBX    Class C: NIICX    Class R: CLIRX

Class Z: NIPAX

        

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class A: NLFAX

   Class B: NLOBX    Class C: NLFCX    Class Z: CLGZX

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class A: NMTAX

   Class B: NMTBX    Class C: NMYCX    Class R: CMTRX

Class Z: NMYAX

        

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class A: NFEAX

   Class B: NFEBX    Class C: NFECX    Class I: —  

Class Z: NFEPX

        

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class A: COGAX

   Class C: COGCX    Class R: COGRX    Class Z: COGZX


Table of Contents

Fund

              

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A: NMGIX

   Class B: NGIBX    Class C: NMICX    Class I: —  

Class R: CMWRX

   Class W: CMSWX    Class Z: NGIPX   

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class A: MAIOX

   Class B: MBIOX    Class C: MCIOX    Class I: —  

Class R: CMORX

   Class Z: NMOAX      

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NMDMX

   Class B: NMITX    Class C: NMINX    Class Z: NMDBX

Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Class A: CMTAX

   Class B: CMTBX    Class C: CMTCX    Class R: CMERX

Class Z: CMTZX

        

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A: NTIAX

   Class R: —      Class Z: NMPAX   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class A: CMUAX

   Class B: CMUBX    Class C: CMUCX    Class I: —  

Class R: CMVRX

   Class R4*: —      Class W: CMUWX    Class Y: CMVYX

Class Z: NAMAX

        

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Class A: NIIAX

   Class B: NIENX    Class C: NITRX    Class I: —  

Class R: CIERX

   Class R4*: —      Class W: CMAWX    Class Z: NEIQX

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NNCIX

   Class B: NNITX    Class C: NNINX    Class Z: NNIBX

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Class A: ––

   Class C: —      Class R: —      Class Z: COSZX

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class A: NSTRX

   Class B: NSTFX    Class C: NSTIX    Class I: ––

Class R: CSBRX

   Class R4*: —      Class W: CSBWX    Class Y: CSBYX

Class Z: NSTMX

        

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NSMMX

   Class B: NSMNX    Class C: NSMUX    Class Z: NSMIX

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class A: NSCGX

   Class B: NCPBX    Class C: NCPCX    Class Z: PSCPX

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A: NMSAX

   Class Z: NMSCX      

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class A: COVAX

   Class B: COVBX    Class C: COVCX    Class I: —  

Class R: CCTRX

   Class Z: NSVAX      

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NSCIX

   Class B: NISCX    Class C: NSICX    Class Z: NSCMX

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class A: NSFAX

   Class B: NSFNX    Class C: NSFCX    Class Z: NSFIX

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NVAFX

   Class B: NVANX    Class C: NVRCX    Class Z: NVABX

Columbia Corporate Bond Portfolio

Shares: NCOBX

        

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Shares: NMTGX

        


Table of Contents

 

This Statement of Additional Information (SAI) is not a prospectus, is not a substitute for reading any prospectus and is intended to be read in conjunction with a Fund’s current prospectus. Share classes marked with an “*” have not yet commenced operations as of the date of this SAI. The most recent annual report for each Fund, which includes the Fund’s audited financial statements for its most recent fiscal period, are incorporated by reference into this SAI.

Copies of the Funds’ current prospectuses and annual and semi-annual reports may be obtained without charge by writing Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, by calling Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or by visiting the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com.

 

 

 

 

C-6518 A (9/10)


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

SAI PRIMER

     1   

ABOUT THE TRUST

     6   

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

     8   

Certain Investment Activity Limits

     8   

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     8   

Exemptive Orders

     11   

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

     12   

Borrowings

     53   

Short Sales

     53   

Lending Securities

     55   

Portfolio Turnover

     55   

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

     56   

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

     61   

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

     61   

The Subadvisers and Investment Subadvisory Services

     84   

The Administrator

     98   

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

     102   

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

     106   

Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

     113   

Other Services Provided

     117   

Distribution and Servicing Plans

     119   

Expense Limitations

     125   

Codes of Ethics

     127   

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

     128   

Expenses Paid by Third Parties

     128   

FUND GOVERNANCE

     130   

The Board

     130   

The Officers

     143   

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

     149   

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

     149   

Brokerage Commissions

     151   

Directed Brokerage

     154   

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

     155   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

     158   

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

     160   

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

     163   

Description of the Trust’s Shares

     163   

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

     167   

Purchase and Redemption

     167   

Offering Price

     170   

TAXATION

     172   

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

     190   

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     237   

APPENDIX A — DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

     A-1   

APPENDIX B — PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

     B-1   

APPENDIX C — SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

     C-1   

APPENDIX D — DESCRIPTION OF STATE CONDITIONS

     D-1   

APPENDIX E — LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

     E-1   

APPENDIX F — LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

     F-1   


Table of Contents

 

SAI PRIMER

The SAI is a part of the Funds’ registration statement that is filed with the SEC. The registration statement includes the Funds’ prospectuses, the SAI and certain exhibits. The SAI, and any supplements to it, can be found online at www.columbiamanagement.com, or by accessing the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

The SAI generally provides additional information about the Funds that is not required to be in the Funds’ prospectuses. The SAI expands discussions of certain matters described in the Funds’ prospectuses and provides certain additional information about the Funds that may be of interest to some investors. Among other things, the SAI provides information about:

 

   

the organization of the Trust;

 

   

the Funds’ investments;

 

   

the Funds’ investment adviser, investment subadviser(s) (if any) and other service providers, including roles and relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and conflicts of interest;

 

   

the governance of the Funds;

 

   

the Funds’ brokerage practices;

 

   

the share classes offered by the Funds;

 

   

the purchase, redemption and pricing of Fund shares; and

 

   

the application of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Investors may find this information important and helpful. If you have any questions about the Funds, please call Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or contact your financial advisor.

Before reading the SAI, you should consult the Glossary below, which defines certain of the terms used in the SAI.

Glossary

 

1933 Act

   Securities Act of 1933, as amended

1934 Act

   Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended

1940 Act

   Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended

Administrative Services Agreement

   The administrative services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Administrator

Administrator

   Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC

Adviser

   Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC

Ameriprise Financial

   Ameriprise Financial, Inc.

Asset Allocation Fund II

   Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

BANA

   Bank of America, National Association

Bank of America

   Bank of America Corporation

BFDS/DST

   Boston Financial Data Services, Inc./DST Systems, Inc.

Board

   The Trust’s Board of Trustees

Brandes

   Brandes Investment Partners, L.P.

 

1


Table of Contents
California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

CMOs

   Collateralized mortgage obligations

Code

   Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended

Codes of Ethics

   The codes of ethics adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act

Columbia Funds Complex

   The mutual fund complex that is comprised of the open-end investment management companies advised by the Adviser or its affiliates and principally underwritten by Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., including funds using the RiverSource, Threadneedle and Seligman brands and funds using the Columbia brand
Columbia Funds or Columbia Funds Family    The funds within the Columbia Funds Complex using the Columbia brand

Convertible Securities Fund

   Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Custodian or State Street

   State Street Bank and Trust Company

Distribution Agreement

   The distribution agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Distributor

Distribution Plan(s)

   One or more of the plans adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act for the distribution of the Funds’ shares

Distributor

   Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc.

FDIC

   Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation

Feeder Fund(s)

  

One or more of the series of CFST that invests all of its assets in a

corresponding Master Portfolio that is a series of Columbia Funds

Master Investment Trust, LLC (CMIT)

FHLMC

   The Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

Fitch

   Fitch, Inc.

FNMA

   Federal National Mortgage Association

The Fund(s) or a Fund

   One or more of the open-end management investment companies listed on the front cover of this SAI that are series of the Trust.
Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Global Value Fund

   Columbia Global Value Fund

GNMA

   Government National Mortgage Association

High Income Fund

   Columbia High Income Fund

Independent Trustees

   The Trustees of the Board who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds

Interested Trustee

   A Trustee of the Board who is currently treated as an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds

International Value Fund

   Columbia International Value Fund

 

2


Table of Contents
Investment Management Services Agreement    The investment management services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Adviser

Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement

   The investment subadvisory agreement among the Trust on behalf of the Fund(s), the Adviser and a Fund’s investment subadviser(s), as the context may require

IRS

   United States Internal Revenue Service

Large Cap Core Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Large Cap Index Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Large Cap Value Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio
LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

LifeGoal® Portfolios

   Each of LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio and LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

LIBOR

   London Interbank Offered Rate

MacKay Shields

   MacKay Shields LLC, the investment subadviser to High Income Fund

Marsico

   Marsico Capital Management, LLC

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Marsico Global Fund

   Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Marsico Growth Fund

   Columbia Marsico Growth Fund
Marsico International Opportunities Fund    Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund
Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Mid Cap Index Fund

   Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

   Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Moody’s

   Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.
Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

NASDAQ

   National Association of Securities Dealers Automated Quotations system

 

3


Table of Contents
North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

NRSRO

   Nationally recognized statistical ratings organization (such as Moody’s, Fitch or S&P)

NSCC

   National Securities Clearing Corporation

NYSE

   New York Stock Exchange

Overseas Value Fund

   Columbia Overseas Value Fund

The Portfolio(s) or a Portfolio

  

One or more of the open-end management investment companies

listed on the front cover of this SAI that are series of the Trust

Previous Administrator

   Columbia Management Advisors, LLC

Previous Adviser

   Columbia Management Advisors, LLC

Previous Distributor

   Columbia Management Distributors, Inc.

Previous Transfer Agent

   Columbia Management Services, Inc.

REIT

   Real estate investment trust

REMIC

   Real estate mortgage investment conduit

RIC

   A “regulated investment company,” as such term is used in the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended

S&P

   Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“Standard & Poor’s” and “S&P” are trademarks of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. and have been licensed for use by the Adviser. The Columbia Funds are not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by Standard & Poor’s and Standard & Poor’s makes no representation regarding the advisability of investing in the Columbia Funds).

SAI

   This Statement of Additional Information

SEC

   United States Securities and Exchange Commission

Selling Agent(s)

   One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a sales support agreement with the Distributor

Servicing Agent(s)

   One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a shareholder servicing agreement with the Distributor

Short Term Bond Fund

   Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Small Cap Index Fund

   Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Small Cap Value Fund II

   Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II
South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Total Return Bond Fund

   Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

 

4


Table of Contents

Transfer Agency Agreement

   The transfer agency agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.

Transfer Agent

   Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.

The Trust

   Columbia Funds Series Trust, the registered investment company in the Columbia Funds Family to which this SAI relates

Trustee(s)

   One or more of the Board’s Trustees
Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

 

5


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE TRUST

The Trust is a registered investment company under the 1940 Act within the Columbia Funds Family. Columbia Funds currently include more than 100 mutual funds in major asset classes, and the Adviser had approximately $301.8 billion assets under management as of June 30, 2010.

The Trust was organized as a Delaware business trust, a form of entity now known as a statutory trust, on October 22, 1999. On September 26, 2005, the Trust changed its name from Nations Funds Trust to Columbia Funds Series Trust.

Funds and portfolios that bore the “Columbia” and “Columbia Acorn” brands prior to September 27, 2010 are collectively referred to herein as the Legacy Columbia funds. For a list of Legacy Columbia funds, see Appendix E. Funds and portfolios that historically bore the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle brands, including those renamed to bear the “Columbia” brand effective September 27, 2010, as well as certain other funds are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds. For a list of Legacy RiverSource funds, see Appendix F.

Funds with a fiscal year end of February 28

On or about September 26, 2005, the names of certain of the Funds were changed as follows: Nations Convertible Securities Fund to Columbia Convertible Securities Fund, Nations Value Fund to Columbia Large Cap Value Fund, Nations Marsico 21st Century Fund to Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund, Nations MidCap Value Fund to Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, Nations SmallCap Value Fund to Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II, Nations Strategic Growth Fund to Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Nations Marsico Focused Equities Fund to Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Nations Marsico Growth Fund to Columbia Marsico Growth Fund, Nations Small Company Fund to Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, Nations Global Value Fund to Columbia Global Value Fund, Nations Marsico International Opportunities Fund to Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Nations International Equity Fund to Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, Nations International Value Fund to Columbia International Value Fund, Nations LargeCap Index Fund to Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Nations MidCap Index Fund to Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Nations SmallCap Index Fund to Columbia Small Cap Index Fund and Nations LargeCap Enhanced Core Fund to Nations Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund.

On February 28, 2008, each of Large Cap Core Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Small Cap Growth Fund II converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund. On November 10, 2008, Marsico Growth Fund converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund.

Prior to August 2006, Convertible Securities Fund, Global Value Fund, Large Cap Value Fund, Marsico 21st Century Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, Mid Cap Value Fund, Small Cap Value Fund II, Large Cap Index Fund, Mid Cap Index Fund, Small Cap Index Fund, Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund each had a fiscal year end of March 31.

Prior to October 2007, International Value Fund, Large Cap Core Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Marsico Growth Fund and Small Cap Growth Fund II each had a fiscal year end of March 31.

International Value Fund is a Feeder Fund that seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing substantially all of its assets in another mutual fund (the Master Portfolio) with the same investment objective, principal investment strategies and investment risks. The Master Portfolio is a separate series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. As of March 30, 2007, Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC converted from a Delaware statutory trust to a Delaware limited liability company. Remember that the terms “Fund” and “Master Portfolio” are sometimes used interchangeably in this SAI.

 

6


Table of Contents

 

Each of the Funds represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end management investment company. Each of the Funds is diversified, except Marsico Focused Equities Fund. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of February 28. For more information on the classes of shares offered by the Funds, see Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Funds with a fiscal year end of March 31

On September 26, 2005, the names of certain of the Funds were changed as follows: Asset Allocation Fund to Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II, Nations California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Nations Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Short-Term Income Fund to Columbia Short Term Bond Fund, Nations Short-Term Municipal Income Fund to Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Bond Fund to Columbia Total Return Bond Fund, Nations High Yield Bond Fund to Columbia High Income Fund, Nations LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, Nations LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, Nations LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio and Nations LifeGoal® Income Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio.

On February 28, 2008, High Income Fund converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund.

Each of the LifeGoal® Portfolios is a “fund of funds” that invests its assets in a mix of Underlying Funds using an asset allocation approach.

Masters International Equity Portfolio was first offered as a series of the Trust on February 15, 2006. The Portfolio is a “fund of funds” that invests its assets in a mix of Underlying Funds using an asset allocation approach.

Each of the Funds represents a separate series of the Trust and, except for the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of March 31. For more information on the classes of shares offered by the Funds, see Capital Stock and Other Securities.

 

7


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

The investment objectives, principal investment strategies (i.e., as used in this SAI and the corresponding prospectuses, a strategy which generally involves the ability to invest 10% or more of a Fund’s total assets) and related principal risks for each Fund are discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Certain Investment Activity Limits

The overall investment and other activities of the Adviser and its affiliates may limit the investment opportunities for each Fund in certain markets where limitations are imposed by regulators upon the amount of investment by affiliated investors, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. From time to time, each Fund’s activities also may be restricted because of regulatory restrictions applicable to the Adviser and its affiliates and/or because of their internal policies. See Investment Advisory and Other Services — Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates — Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

The following discussion of “fundamental” and “non-fundamental” investment policies and limitations for each Fund supplements the discussion of investment policies in the Funds’ prospectuses. A fundamental policy may be changed only with Board and shareholder approval. A non-fundamental policy may be changed by the Board and does not require shareholder approval, but may require notice to shareholders in certain instances.

Unless otherwise noted, whenever an investment policy or limitation states a maximum percentage of a Fund’s assets that may be invested in any security or other asset, or sets forth a policy regarding an investment standard, compliance with such percentage limitation or standard will be determined solely at the time of the Fund’s acquisition of such security or asset. Borrowings and other instruments that may give rise to leverage and the restriction on investing in illiquid securities are monitored on an ongoing basis.

Fundamental Investment Policies

The 1940 Act provides that a “vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities” means the affirmative vote of the lesser of (1) more than 50% of the outstanding shares of a Fund, or (2) 67% or more of the shares present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding shares are represented at the meeting in person or by proxy. The following fundamental investment policies cannot be changed without such a vote.

Overseas Value Fund may not, as a matter of fundamental policy:

 

  1. Underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies;

 

  2. Purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein;

 

  3. Purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts;

 

8


Table of Contents

 

  4. Purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief;

 

  5. Make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief;

 

  6. Borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief; and

 

  7. Purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

Each Fund other than Overseas Value Fund may not, as a matter of fundamental policy:

 

  1. Underwrite any issue of securities within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might technically be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with its investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered management investment companies;

 

  2. Purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate and may purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate;

 

  3. Purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may, to the extent consistent with its investment objective, invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, and purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions, including, without limitation, forward currency contracts;

 

  4. Purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States, or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds;

 

  5. Make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds;

 

  6. Borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds; and

 

  7.

Except Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the

 

9


Table of Contents
 

securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds.

As a matter of fundamental policy, under normal circumstances, California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, each will invest at least 80% of its assets in securities that pay interest exempt from federal income tax, other than the federal alternative minimum tax, and state individual income tax.

As a matter of fundamental policy, under normal circumstances, Short Term Municipal Bond Fund will invest at least 80% of its assets in securities that pay interest exempt from federal income tax, other than the federal alternative minimum tax.

Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

 

Fund

   May Not Invest
more than 15%
of its net assets
in illiquid
securities(a)
     May not sell
securities
short(b)
     May not
purchase
securities of
other investment
companies(c)
     Provides 60
day notice in
connection with
Rule 35d-1
changes(d)
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

   ü         ü         ü        

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Convertible Securities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Global Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

High Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

International Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico Global Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico Growth Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mid Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mid Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Overseas Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

 

10


Table of Contents

Fund

   May Not Invest
more than 15%
of its net assets
in illiquid
securities(a)
     May not sell
securities
short(b)
     May not
purchase
securities of
other investment
companies(c)
     Provides 60
day notice in
connection with
Rule 35d-1
changes(d)
 

Short Term Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Small Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Small Cap Value Fund II

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Total Return Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

 

a

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, invest more than 15% of their net assets in illiquid securities. “Illiquid Securities” is defined in accordance with the SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is a security which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which the fund has valued the security.

b

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

c

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of one of these Funds are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.

d

To the extent a Fund with a check mark in this column is subject to Rule 35d-1 under the 1940 Act (the Names Rule), and does not otherwise have a fundamental investment policy in place to comply with the Names Rule, such Fund has adopted the following non-fundamental policy: Shareholders will receive at least 60 days’ notice of any change to the Fund’s investment objective or principal investment strategies made in order to comply with the Names Rule. The notice will be provided in plain English in a separate written document, and will contain the following prominent statement or similar statement in bold-face type: “Important Notice Regarding Change in Investment Policy.” This statement will appear on both the notice and the envelope in which it is delivered, unless it is delivered separately from other communications to investors, in which case the statement will appear either on the notice or the envelope in which the notice is delivered.

Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund may not purchase securities of any one issuer (other than U.S. Government Obligations and securities of other investment companies) if, immediately after such purchase, more than 25% of the value of the Funds total assets would be invested in the securities of one issuer, and with respect to 50% of the Fund’s total assets, more than 5% of its assets would be invested in the securities of one issuer.

Exemptive Orders

In addition to the policies outlined above, the Columbia Funds Family has received the following exemptive orders from the SEC which enable the Fund to participate in certain transactions beyond the investment limitations described above or described in otherwise applicable restrictions:

 

  1.

Pursuant to an exemptive order dated October 5, 1993, all current and future Funds advised by the Adviser may, subject to certain conditions, pool their uninvested cash balances in one or more joint

 

11


Table of Contents
 

accounts and use the daily balance of such accounts to enter into repurchase agreements, including the condition that such agreements have a maturity of not more than seven days.

 

  2. Pursuant to an exemptive order dated September 5, 2003, the Fund may, subject to certain conditions, borrow money from other Funds in the Columbia Funds Family for temporary emergency purposes in order to facilitate redemption requests, or for other purposes consistent with Fund investment policies and restrictions. All loans are set at an interest rate between the rates charged on overnight repurchase agreements and short-term bank loans.

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

Each Fund’s prospectuses identify and summarize the individual types of securities in which the Fund invests as part of its principal investment strategies and the principal risks associated with such investments.

The table below identifies certain types of securities in which each Fund is permitted to invest, including certain types of securities that are described in each Fund’s prospectuses. A Fund generally has the ability to invest 10% or more of its total assets in each type of security described in its prospectuses (and in each sub-category of such security type described in this SAI). To the extent that a type of security identified below for a Fund is not described in the Fund’s prospectuses (or as a sub-category of such security type in this SAI), the Fund generally invests less than 10% of the Fund’s total assets in such security type.

Information about individual types of securities (including certain of their associated risks) in which some or all of the Funds may invest is set forth below. Each Fund’s investment in these types of securities is subject to its investment objective and fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies.

Temporary Defensive Positions. Each Fund may temporarily invest in money market instruments or hold cash. It may do so without limit, when the Adviser or the Fund’s subadviser, if applicable: (i) believes that the market conditions are not favorable for profitable investing; (ii) is unable to locate favorable investment opportunities; or (iii) determines that a temporary defensive position is advisable or necessary in order to meet anticipated redemption requests, or for other reasons. While a Fund engages in such strategies, it may not achieve its investment objective. See also About the Funds’ Investments — Permissible Investments and Related Risks — Money Market Instruments.

Permissible Fund Investments

 

Investment Type

   Asset
Allocation
Fund II
    California
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Convertible
Securities
Fund
    Corporate
Bond
Portfolio
    Georgia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Global
Value
Fund
    High
Income
Fund
    International
Value Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

                

Domestic

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

   ü                   

 

12


Table of Contents

Investment Type

   Asset
Allocation
Fund II
    California
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Convertible
Securities
Fund
    Corporate
Bond
Portfolio
    Georgia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Global
Value
Fund
    High
Income
Fund
    International
Value Fund
 

Derivatives

                

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

       ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

                 ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Municipal Securities

   ü        ü          ü        ü           

Participation Interests

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Standby Commitments

   ü                   

Stripped Securities

   ü          ü        ü          ü          ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

13


Table of Contents

Investment Type

   Asset
Allocation
Fund II
    California
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Convertible
Securities
Fund
    Corporate
Bond
Portfolio
    Georgia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Global
Value
Fund
    High
Income
Fund
    International
Value Fund
 

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Warrants and Rights

   ü          ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

   ü          ü        ü          ü          ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

  Large Cap
Core Fund
    Large Cap
Enhanced

Core  Fund
    Large Cap
Index Fund
    Large Cap
Value
Fund
    LifeGoal®
Balanced
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income

and Growth
Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income
Portfolio
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

               

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

Derivatives

               

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü          ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

14


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Large Cap
Core Fund
    Large Cap
Enhanced

Core  Fund
    Large Cap
Index Fund
    Large Cap
Value
Fund
    LifeGoal®
Balanced
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income

and Growth
Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income
Portfolio
 

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

  Marsico  21st
Century
Fund
    Marsico
Focused
Equities Fund
    Marsico
Global Fund
    Marsico
Growth Fund
    Marsico
International
Opportunities
Fund
    Maryland
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Masters
International
Equity
Portfolio
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

             

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

              ü     

 

15


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Marsico  21st
Century
Fund
    Marsico
Focused
Equities Fund
    Marsico
Global Fund
    Marsico
Growth Fund
    Marsico
International
Opportunities
Fund
    Maryland
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Masters
International
Equity
Portfolio
 

Derivatives

             

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

             

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

      ü            ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

16


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Marsico  21st
Century
Fund
    Marsico
Focused
Equities Fund
    Marsico
Global Fund
    Marsico
Growth Fund
    Marsico
International
Opportunities
Fund
    Maryland
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Masters
International
Equity
Portfolio
 

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

      ü              ü     

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

  Mid
Cap
Index
Fund
    Mid
Cap
Value
Fund
    Mortgage-
and Asset-
Backed
Portfolio
    Multi-Advisor
International
Equity Fund
    North
Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Overseas
Value
Fund
    Short
Term
Bond Fund
    Short Term
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

               

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

               

Derivatives

               

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü       

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

17


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Mid
Cap
Index
Fund
    Mid
Cap
Value
Fund
    Mortgage-
and Asset-
Backed
Portfolio
    Multi-Advisor
International
Equity Fund
    North
Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Overseas
Value
Fund
    Short
Term
Bond Fund
    Short Term
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

    ü        ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

               

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

      ü          ü          ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

               

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü            ü        ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

   Small Cap
Growth
Fund II
     Small Cap
Index Fund
     Small Cap
Value

Fund II
     South Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal

Bond Fund
     Total
Return
Bond Fund
     Virginia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Bank Obligations

                 

Domestic

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Common Stock

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Convertible Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

 

18


Table of Contents

Investment Type

   Small Cap
Growth
Fund II
     Small Cap
Index Fund
     Small Cap
Value

Fund II
     South Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal

Bond Fund
     Total
Return
Bond Fund
     Virginia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

                 

Derivatives

                 

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Swap Agreements

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Dollar Rolls

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Illiquid Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Initial Public Offerings

   ü            ü            ü        

Investing in a Master Portfolio

                 

Investments in Other Investment Companies

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Money Market Instruments

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Municipal Securities

            ü         ü         ü     

Participation Interests

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Preferred Stock

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Repurchase Agreements

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Standby Commitments

                 

Stripped Securities

   ü         ü         ü            ü        

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Warrants and Rights

   ü         ü         ü            ü        

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

   ü         ü         ü            ü        

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

 

19


Table of Contents

 

Asset-Backed Securities

Asset-backed securities represent interests in, or debt instruments that are backed by, pools of various types of assets that generate cash payments generally over fixed periods of time. Such securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying assets (less fees paid to the originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying assets effectively pass through to such security holders. Asset-backed securities typically are created by an originator of loans or owner of accounts receivable that sells such underlying assets to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying assets, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Asset-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in asset-backed securities is subject to certain risks. For example, the value of asset-backed securities may be affected by, among other factors, changes in: interest rates, the market’s assessment of the quality of underlying assets, the creditworthiness of the servicer for the underlying assets, information concerning the originator of the underlying assets, or the creditworthiness or rating of the entities that provide any supporting letters of credit, surety bonds, derivative instruments, or other credit enhancement. The value of asset-backed securities also will be affected by the exhaustion, termination or expiration of any credit enhancement.

Declining or low interest rates may lead to a more rapid rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in accelerated payments on asset-backed securities that then would be reinvested at a lesser rate of interest. Rising or high interest rates tend to lead to a slower rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in slower than expected payments on asset-backed securities that can, in turn, lead to a decline in value. The impact of changing interest rates on the value of asset-backed securities may be difficult to predict and result in greater volatility. Holders of asset-backed securities generally have no recourse against the originator of the underlying assets in the event of a default on the underlying assets. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of asset-backed securities, backed by pools of receivables such as mortgage loans, may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or an underlying obligor has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for asset-backed securities that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of an asset-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be.

Bank Obligations (Domestic and Foreign)

Bank obligations include certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances, time deposits and promissory notes that earn a specified rate of return and may be issued by (i) a domestic branch of a domestic bank, (ii) a foreign branch of a domestic bank, (iii) a domestic branch of a foreign bank or (iv) a foreign branch of a foreign bank. Bank obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

Certificates of deposit, or so-called CDs, typically are interest-bearing debt instruments issued by banks and have maturities ranging from a few weeks to several years. Bankers’ acceptances are time drafts drawn on and accepted by banks, are a customary means of effecting payment for merchandise sold in import-export transactions and are a general source of financing. Yankee dollar certificates of deposit are negotiable CDs issued in the United States by branches and agencies of foreign banks. Eurodollar certificates of deposit are CDs issued by foreign (mainly European) banks with interest and principal paid in U.S. dollars. Such CDs typically have maturities of less than two years and have interest rates that typically are pegged to the London Interbank Offered

 

20


Table of Contents

Rate or LIBOR. A time deposit can be either a savings account or CD that is an obligation of a financial institution for a fixed term. Typically, there are penalties for early withdrawals of time deposits. Promissory notes are written commitments of the maker to pay the payee a specified sum of money either on demand or at a fixed or determinable future date, with or without interest.

Bank investment contracts are issued by banks. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of a bank. The bank then credits to the Fund payments at floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund also may hold funds on deposit with its custodian for temporary purposes.

Investing in bank obligations is subject to certain risks. Certain bank obligations, such as some CDs, are insured by the FDIC up to certain specified limits. Many other bank obligations, however, are neither guaranteed nor insured by the FDIC or the U.S. Government. These bank obligations are “backed” only by the creditworthiness of the issuing bank or parent financial institution. Domestic and foreign banks are subject to different governmental regulation. Accordingly, certain obligations of foreign banks, including Eurodollar and Yankee dollar obligations, involve different investment risks than those affecting obligations of domestic banks, including, among others, the possibilities that: (i) their liquidity could be impaired because of political or economic developments; (ii) the obligations may be less marketable than comparable obligations of domestic banks; (iii) a foreign jurisdiction might impose withholding and other taxes at high levels on interest income; (iv) foreign deposits may be seized or nationalized; (v) foreign governmental restrictions such as exchange controls may be imposed, which could adversely affect the payment of principal or interest on those obligations; (vi) there may be less publicly available information concerning foreign banks issuing the obligations; and (vii) the reserve requirements and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards, practices and requirements applicable to foreign banks may differ from those applicable to domestic banks. Foreign banks generally are not subject to examination by any U.S. Government agency or instrumentality.

Common Stock

Common stock represents a unit of equity ownership of a corporation. Owners typically are entitled to vote on the selection of directors and other important corporate governance matters, and to receive dividend payments, if any, on their holdings. However, ownership of common stock does not entitle owners to participate in the day-to-day operations of the corporation. Common stocks of domestic and foreign public corporations can be listed, and their shares traded, on domestic stock exchanges, such as the NYSE or the NASDAQ Stock Market. Domestic and foreign corporations also may have their shares traded on foreign exchanges, such as the London Stock Exchange or Tokyo Stock Exchange. Common stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in common stocks is subject to certain risks. Stock market risk, for example, is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods of time, perhaps substantially or unexpectedly. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when stock prices generally rise and periods when stock prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and fall based on factors specific to each company, such as changes in earnings or management, as well as general economic and market factors.

If a corporation is liquidated, the claims of secured and unsecured creditors and owners of debt securities and “preferred” stock take priority over the claims of those who own common stock.

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to the particular type of company issuing the common stock. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price swings than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, may be more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Common stocks of these types of companies may have a higher potential for gains, but also may be subject to greater risk of loss.

 

21


Table of Contents

 

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of common stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably affect, an industry, the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry to decline quickly.

Convertible Securities

Convertible securities include bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks or other securities that may be converted or exchanged (by the holder or by the issuer) into shares of the underlying common stock (or cash or securities of equivalent value) at a stated exchange ratio or predetermined price (the conversion price). As such, convertible securities combine the investment characteristics of debt securities and equity securities. A holder of convertible securities is entitled to receive the income of a bond, debenture or note or the dividend of a preferred stock until the conversion privilege is exercised. The market value of convertible securities generally is a function of, among other factors, interest rates, the rates of return of similar nonconvertible securities and the financial strength of the issuer. The market value of convertible securities tends to decline as interest rates rise and, conversely, to rise as interest rates decline. However, a convertible security’s market value tends to reflect the market price of the common stock of the issuing company when that stock price approaches or is greater than its conversion price. As the market price of the underlying common stock declines, the price of the convertible security tends to be influenced more by the rate of return of the convertible security. Because both interest rate and market movements can influence their value, convertible securities generally are not as sensitive to changes in interest rates as similar debt securities nor generally are they as sensitive to changes in share price as their underlying common stock. Convertible securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in convertible securities is subject to certain risks. Certain convertible securities, particularly securities that are convertible into securities of an issuer other than the issuer of the convertible security, may be illiquid and, therefore, may be more difficult to resell in a timely fashion or for a fair price, which could result in investment losses. Certain convertible securities may have a mandatory conversion feature, pursuant to which the securities convert automatically into common stock or other equity securities (of the same or a different issuer) at a specified date and a specified exchange ratio. Certain convertible securities may be convertible at the option of the issuer, which may require a holder to convert the security into the underlying common stock, even at times when the value of the underlying common stock or other equity security has declined substantially. In addition, some convertible securities may be rated below investment grade or may not be rated and, therefore, may be considered speculative investments. Companies that issue convertible securities frequently are small- and mid-capitalization companies and, accordingly, carry the risks associated with such companies. In addition, the credit rating of a company’s convertible securities generally is lower than that of its conventional debt securities. Convertible securities are senior to equity securities and have a claim to the assets of an issuer prior to the holders of the issuer’s common stock in the event of liquidation but generally are subordinate to similar non-convertible debt securities of the same issuer. Some convertible securities are particularly sensitive to changes in interest rates when their predetermined conversion price is much higher than the price for the issuing company’s common stock.

Corporate Debt Securities

Corporate debt securities are fixed income securities typically issued by businesses to finance their operations. Notes, bonds, debentures and commercial paper are the most common types of corporate debt securities, with the primary difference being their interest rates, maturity dates and secured or unsecured status.

 

22


Table of Contents

Commercial paper has the shortest term and usually is unsecured. The broad category of corporate debt securities includes debt issued by domestic or foreign companies of all kinds, including those with small-, mid- and large-capitalizations. The category also includes bank loans, as well as assignments, participations and other interests in bank loans. Corporate debt securities may be rated investment grade or below investment grade and may be structured as fixed-, variable or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Extendible commercial notes (ECNs) are very similar to commercial paper except that with ECNs, the issuer has the option to extend the notes’ maturity. ECNs are issued at a discount rate, with an initial redemption of not more than 90 days from the date of issue. If ECNs are not redeemed by the issuer on the initial redemption date, the issuer will pay a premium (step-up) rate based on the ECN’s credit rating at the time.

Because of the wide range of types and maturities of corporate debt securities, as well as the range of creditworthiness of issuers, corporate debt securities can have widely varying risk/return profiles. For example, commercial paper issued by a large established domestic corporation that is rated by an NRSRO as investment grade may have a relatively modest return on principal but present relatively limited risk. On the other hand, a long-term corporate note issued, for example, by a small foreign corporation from an emerging market country that has not been rated by an NRSRO may have the potential for relatively large returns on principal but carries a relatively high degree of risk.

Investing in corporate debt securities is subject to certain risks including, among others, credit and interest rate risk. Credit risk is the risk that a Fund could lose money if the issuer of a corporate debt security is unable to pay interest or repay principal when it becomes due. Some corporate debt securities that are rated below investment grade by an NRSRO generally are considered speculative because they present a greater risk of loss, including default, than higher quality debt securities. The credit risk of a particular issuer’s debt security may vary based on its priority for repayment. For example, higher ranking (senior) debt securities have a higher priority than and, therefore, may be paid in full before, lower ranking (subordinated) securities. In addition, in the event of bankruptcy, holders of higher-ranking senior securities may receive amounts otherwise payable to the holders of more junior securities. Interest rate risk is the risk that the value of certain corporate debt securities will tend to fall when interest rates rise. In general, corporate debt securities with longer terms tend to fall more in value when interest rates rise than do corporate debt securities with shorter terms.

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

Custody receipts and trust certificates are derivative products that evidence direct ownership in a pool of securities. Typically, a sponsor will deposit a pool of securities with a custodian in exchange for custody receipts evidencing interests in those securities. The sponsor generally then will sell the custody receipts or trust certificates in negotiated transactions at varying prices. Each custody receipt or trust certificate evidences the individual securities in the pool and the holder of a custody receipt or trust certificate generally will have all the rights and privileges of owners of those securities.

Investing in custody receipts and trust certificates is subject to certain risks. Custody receipts and trust certificates generally are subject to the same risks as the securities evidenced by the receipts or certificates. Custody receipts and trust certificates also may be less liquid than the underlying securities.

Derivatives

General

Derivatives are financial instruments whose values are based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or a bond), assets (such as a commodity, like gold), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market

 

23


Table of Contents

indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Some forms of derivatives, such as exchange-traded futures and options on securities, commodities, or indices, are traded on regulated exchanges. These types of derivatives are standardized contracts that can easily be bought and sold, and whose market values are determined and published daily. Non-standardized derivatives, on the other hand, tend to be more specialized or complex, and may be harder to value. Derivatives afford leverage and, when used properly, can enhance returns and be useful in hedging portfolios. Some common types of derivatives include futures; options; options on futures; forward foreign currency exchange contracts; forward contracts on securities and securities indices; linked securities and structured products; CMOs; stripped securities; warrants; swap agreements and swaptions.

A Fund may use derivatives for a variety of reasons, including, for example: (i) to enhance its return; (ii) to attempt to protect against possible changes in the market value of securities held in or to be purchased for its portfolio resulting from securities markets or currency exchange rate fluctuations (i.e., to hedge); (iii) to protect its unrealized gains reflected in the value of its portfolio securities; (iv) to facilitate the sale of such securities for investment purposes; (v) to reduce transaction costs; and/or (vi) to manage the effective maturity or duration of its portfolio.

A Fund’s use of derivatives presents risks different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in traditional securities. The use of derivatives can lead to losses because of adverse movements in the price or value of the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate, which may be magnified by certain features of the derivatives. These risks are heightened when a Fund uses derivatives to enhance its return or as a substitute for a position or security, rather than solely to hedge or offset the risk of a position or security held by a Fund. There is also a risk that the derivative will not correlate well with the security for which it is substituting. A Fund’s use of derivatives to leverage risk also may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing a Fund to lose more money than if it had invested in the underlying security, or limit a potential gain. The success of management’s derivative strategies will depend on its ability to assess and predict the impact of market or economic developments on the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate and the derivative itself, without necessarily the benefit of observing the performance of the derivative under all possible market conditions. Other risks arise from a Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell its derivative positions as a liquid secondary market for such positions may not exist at times when a Fund may wish to terminate or sell them. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid. Derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. Also, with some derivative strategies there is the risk that a Fund may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to invest in derivatives altogether. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount and accelerate the timing of taxes payable by shareholders.

A Fund may use any or all of the above investment techniques and may purchase different types of derivative instruments at any time and in any combination. There is no particular strategy that dictates the use of one technique over another, as the use of derivatives is a function of numerous variables, including market conditions.

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

General. Indexed or linked securities, also often referred to as “structured products,” are instruments that may have varying combinations of equity and debt characteristics. These instruments are structured to recast the investment characteristics of the underlying security or reference asset. If the issuer is a unit investment trust or other special purpose vehicle, the structuring will typically involve the deposit with or purchase by such issuer of specified instruments (such as commercial bank loans or securities) and/or the execution of various derivative transactions, and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of securities (structured securities) backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying instruments. The cash flow on the underlying instruments may be apportioned among the newly issued structured securities to create securities with different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, payment priorities and interest rate provisions, and the extent of such payments made with respect to structured securities is dependent on the extent of the cash flow on the underlying instruments.

 

24


Table of Contents

 

Indexed and Inverse Floating Rate Securities. A Fund may invest in securities that provide a potential return based on a particular index of value or interest rates. For example, a Fund may invest in securities that pay interest based on an index of interest rates. The principal amount payable upon maturity of certain securities also may be based on the value of the index. To the extent a Fund invests in these types of securities, a Fund’s return on such securities will rise and fall with the value of the particular index: that is, if the value of the index falls, the value of the indexed securities owned by a Fund will fall. Interest and principal payable on certain securities may also be based on relative changes among particular indices.

A Fund may also invest in so-called “inverse floaters” or “residual interest bonds” on which the interest rates vary inversely with a floating rate (which may be reset periodically by a dutch auction, a remarketing agent, or by reference to a short-term tax-exempt interest rate index). A Fund may purchase synthetically-created inverse floating rate bonds evidenced by custodial or trust receipts. Generally, income on inverse floating rate bonds will decrease when interest rates increase, and will increase when interest rates decrease. Such securities have the effect of providing a degree of investment leverage, since they may increase or decrease in value in response to changes, as an illustration, in market interest rates at a rate that is a multiple of the rate at which fixed-rate securities increase or decrease in response to such changes. As a result, the market values of such securities will generally be more volatile than the market values of fixed-rate securities. To seek to limit the volatility of these securities, a Fund may purchase inverse floating obligations that have shorter-term maturities or that contain limitations on the extent to which the interest rate may vary. Certain investments in such obligations may be illiquid. A Fund may invest in indexed and inverse securities for hedging purposes or to seek to increase returns. When used for hedging purposes, indexed and inverse securities involve correlation risk. Furthermore, where such a security includes a contingent liability, in the event of an adverse movement in the underlying index or interest rate, a Fund may be required to pay substantial additional margin to maintain the position.

Credit Linked Securities. Among the income producing securities in which a Fund may invest are credit linked securities. The issuers of these securities frequently are limited purpose trusts or other special purpose vehicles that, in turn, invest in a derivative instrument or basket of derivative instruments, such as credit default swaps, interest rate swaps and other securities, in order to provide exposure to certain fixed income markets. For instance, a Fund may invest in credit linked securities as a cash management tool in order to gain exposure to a certain market and/or to remain fully invested when more traditional income producing securities are not available.

Like an investment in a bond, investments in these credit linked securities represent the right to receive periodic income payments (in the form of distributions) and payment of principal at the end of the term of the security. However, these payments are conditioned on or linked to the issuer’s receipt of payments from, and the issuer’s potential obligations to, the counterparties to the derivative instruments and other securities in which the issuer invests. For instance, the issuer may sell one or more credit default swaps, under which the issuer would receive a stream of payments over the term of the swap agreements provided that no event of default has occurred with respect to the referenced debt obligation upon which the swap is based. If a default occurs, the stream of payments may stop and the issuer would be obligated to pay the counterparty the par (or other agreed upon value) of the referenced debt obligation. This, in turn, would reduce the amount of income and/or principal that a Fund would receive. A Fund’s investments in these instruments are indirectly subject to the risks associated with derivative instruments, including, among others, credit risk, default or similar event risk, counterparty risk, interest rate risk, leverage risk and management risk. These securities generally are exempt from registration under the 1933 Act. Accordingly, there may be no established trading market for the securities and they may constitute illiquid investments.

Index-, Commodity-, Currency- and Equity-Linked Securities. “Index-linked” or “commodity-linked” notes are debt securities of companies that call for interest payments and/or payment at maturity in different terms than the typical note where the borrower agrees to make fixed interest payments and to pay a fixed sum at maturity. Principal and/or interest payments on an index-linked or commodity-linked note depend on the performance of

 

25


Table of Contents

one or more market indices, such as the S&P 500® Index, a weighted index of commodity futures such as crude oil, gasoline and natural gas or the market prices of a particular commodity or basket of commodities. Equity-linked securities are short-term or intermediate term instruments having a value at maturity and/or interest rate determined by reference to the market prices of one or more equity securities. At maturity, the principal amount of an equity-linked debt security is often exchanged for common stock of the issuer or is payable in an amount based on the issuer’s common stock price at the time of maturity. Currency-linked debt securities are short-term or intermediate-term instruments having a value at maturity, and/or an interest rate, determined by reference to one or more foreign currencies. Payment of principal or periodic interest may be calculated as a multiple of the movement of one currency against another currency, or against an index.

Index, commodity, currency and equity-linked securities may entail substantial risks. Such instruments may be subject to significant price volatility. The company issuing the instrument may fail to pay the amount due on maturity. The underlying investment or security may not perform as expected by the Adviser. Markets, underlying securities and indexes may move in a direction that was not anticipated by the Adviser. Performance of the derivatives may be influenced by interest rate and other market changes in the United States and abroad, and certain derivative instruments may be illiquid.

Linked securities are often issued by unit investment trusts. Examples of this include such index-linked securities as S&P Depositary Receipts (SPDRs), which is an interest in a unit investment trust holding a portfolio of securities linked to the S&P 500® Index, and a type of exchange-traded fund (ETF). Because a unit investment trust is an investment company under the 1940 Act, a Fund’s investments in SPDRs are subject to the limitations set forth in Section 12(d)(1)(A) of the 1940 Act. SPDRs closely track the underlying portfolio of securities, trade like a share of common stock and pay periodic dividends proportionate to those paid by the portfolio of stocks that comprise the S&P 500® Index. As a holder of interests in a unit investment trust, a Fund would indirectly bear its ratable share of that unit investment trust’s expenses. At the same time, a Fund would continue to pay its own management and advisory fees and other expenses, as a result of which a Fund and its shareholders in effect would be absorbing levels of fees with respect to investments in such unit investment trusts.

Equity-linked securities include issues such as Structured Yield Product Exchangeable for Stock (STRYPES), Trust Automatic Common Exchange Securities (TRACES), Trust Issued Mandatory Exchange Securities (TIMES), and Trust Enhanced Dividend Securities (TRENDS). The issuers of these equity-linked securities generally purchase and hold a portfolio of stripped U.S. Treasury securities maturing on a quarterly basis through the conversion date, and a forward purchase contract with an existing shareholder of the company relating to the common stock. Quarterly distributions on such equity-linked securities generally consist of the cash received from the U.S. Treasury securities and such equity-linked securities generally are not entitled to any dividends that may be declared on the common stock.

Investing in structured products and linked securities is subject to certain risks. Because structured products typically involve no credit enhancement, their credit risk generally will be equivalent to that of the underlying instruments. Investments in structured products may be structured as a class that is either subordinated or unsubordinated to the right of payment of another class. Subordinated structured products typically have higher rates of return and present greater risks than unsubordinated structured products. Structured products sometimes are sold in private placement transactions and often have a limited trading market.

Investments in “linked” securities have the potential to lead to significant losses because of unexpected movements in the underlying financial asset, index, currency or other investment. The ability of a Fund to utilize linked-securities successfully will depend on its ability correctly to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. Because currency-linked securities usually relate to foreign currencies, some of which may be currencies from emerging market countries, there are certain additional risks associated with such investments.

SPDRs are subject to the risks of an investment in a broadly based portfolio of common stocks, including the risk that the general level of stock prices may decline, thereby adversely affecting the value of such

 

26


Table of Contents

investment. In addition, because individual investments in SPDRs are not redeemable, except upon termination of the unit investment trust, the liquidity of small holdings of SPDRs will depend upon the existence of a secondary market. Large holdings of SPDRs are called “creation unit size” and are redeemable in-kind only and are not redeemable for cash from the unit investment trust. The price of a SPDR is derived from and based upon the securities held by the unit investment trust. Accordingly, the level of risk involved in the purchase or sale of a SPDR is similar to the risk involved in the purchase or sale of traditional common stock, with the exception that the pricing mechanism for SPDRs is based on a basket of stocks. Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying SPDRs purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on SPDRs.

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

Futures Contracts. A futures contract sale creates an obligation by the seller to deliver the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. A futures contract purchase creates an obligation by the purchaser to take delivery of the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. The specific security or other asset delivered or taken at the settlement date is not determined until on or near that date. The determination is made in accordance with the rules of the exchange on which the futures contract was made. A Fund may enter into futures contracts which are traded on national or foreign futures exchanges and are standardized as to maturity date and underlying security or other asset. Futures exchanges and trading in the United States are regulated under the Commodity Exchange Act (CEA) by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), a U.S. Government agency.

Traders in futures contracts may be broadly classified as either “hedgers” or “speculators.” Hedgers use the futures markets primarily to offset unfavorable changes (anticipated or potential) in the value of securities or other assets currently owned or expected to be acquired by them. Speculators less often own the securities or other assets underlying the futures contracts which they trade, and generally use futures contracts with the expectation of realizing profits from fluctuations in the value of the underlying securities or other assets. Pursuant to a notice of eligibility claiming exclusion from the definition of commodity pool operator filed with the CFTC and the National Futures Association on behalf of the Funds, neither the Trust nor any of the individual Funds is deemed to be a “commodity pool operator” under the CEA, and, accordingly, they are not subject to registration or regulation as such under the CEA.

Upon entering into futures contracts, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities, equal in value to the amount of a Fund’s obligation under the contract (less any applicable margin deposits and any assets that constitute “cover” for such obligation), will be segregated with a Fund’s custodian.

Unlike when a Fund purchases or sells a security, no price is paid or received by a Fund upon the purchase or sale of a futures contract, although a Fund is required to deposit with its custodian in a segregated account in the name of the futures broker an amount of cash and/or U.S. Government securities in order to initiate and maintain open positions in futures contracts. This amount is known as “initial margin.” The nature of initial margin in futures transactions is different from that of margin in security transactions, in that futures contract margin does not involve the borrowing of funds by a Fund to finance the transactions. Rather, initial margin is in the nature of a performance bond or good faith deposit intended to assure completion of the contract (delivery or acceptance of the underlying security or other asset) that is returned to a Fund upon termination of the futures contract, assuming all contractual obligations have been satisfied. Minimum initial margin requirements are established by the relevant futures exchange and may be changed. Brokers may establish deposit requirements which are higher than the exchange minimums. Futures contracts are customarily purchased and sold on margin which may range upward from less than 5% of the value of the contract being traded. Subsequent payments, called “variation margin,” to and from the broker (or the custodian) are made on a daily basis as the price of the underlying security or other asset fluctuates, a process known as “marking to market.” If the futures contract price changes to the extent that the margin on deposit does not satisfy margin requirements, payment of additional variation margin will be required. Conversely, a change in the contract value may reduce the required margin, resulting in a repayment of excess margin to the contract holder. Variation margin payments are made for as long as the contract remains open. A Fund expects to earn interest income on its margin deposits.

 

27


Table of Contents

 

Although futures contracts by their terms call for actual delivery or acceptance of securities or other assets (stock index futures contracts or futures contracts that reference other intangible assets do not permit delivery of the referenced assets), the contracts usually are closed out before the settlement date without the making or taking of delivery. A Fund may elect to close some or all of its futures positions at any time prior to their expiration. The purpose of taking such action would be to reduce or eliminate the position then currently held by a Fund. Closing out an open futures position is done by taking an opposite position (“buying” a contract which has previously been “sold,” “selling” a contract previously “purchased”) in an identical contract (i.e., the same aggregate amount of the specific type of security or other asset with the same delivery date) to terminate the position. Final determinations are made as to whether the price of the initial sale of the futures contract exceeds or is below the price of the offsetting purchase, or whether the purchase price exceeds or is below the offsetting sale price. Final determinations of variation margin are then made, additional cash is required to be paid by or released to a Fund, and a Fund realizes a loss or a gain. Brokerage commissions are incurred when a futures contract is bought or sold.

Successful use of futures contracts by a Fund is subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of interest rates and other factors affecting securities and commodities markets. This requires different skills and techniques than those required to predict changes in the prices of individual securities. A Fund, therefore, bears the risk that future market trends will be incorrectly predicted.

The risk of loss in trading futures contracts in some strategies can be substantial, due both to the relatively low margin deposits required and the potential for an extremely high degree of leverage involved in futures contracts. As a result, a relatively small price movement in a futures contract may result in an immediate and substantial loss to the investor. For example, if at the time of purchase, 10% of the value of the futures contract is deposited as margin, a subsequent 10% decrease in the value of the futures contract would result in a total loss of the margin deposit, before any deduction for the transaction costs, if the account were then closed out. A 15% decrease would result in a loss equal to 150% of the original margin deposit if the contract were closed out. Thus, a purchase or sale of a futures contract may result in losses in excess of the amount posted as initial margin for the contract.

In the event of adverse price movements, a Fund would continue to be required to make daily cash payments in order to maintain its required margin. In such a situation, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell portfolio securities in order to meet daily margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. The inability to close the futures position also could have an adverse impact on the ability to hedge effectively.

To reduce or eliminate a hedge position held by a Fund, a Fund may seek to close out a position. The ability to establish and close out positions will be subject to the development and maintenance of a liquid secondary market. It is not certain that this market will develop or continue to exist for a particular futures contract, which may limit a Fund’s ability to realize its profits or limit its losses. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain contracts; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions, closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of contracts, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of contracts (or a particular class or series of contracts), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of contracts) would cease to exist, although outstanding contracts on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

Interest Rate Futures Contracts. Bond prices are established in both the cash market and the futures market. In the cash market, bonds are purchased and sold with payment for the full purchase price of the bond being

 

28


Table of Contents

made in cash, generally within five business days after the trade. In the futures market, a contract is made to purchase or sell a bond in the future for a set price on a certain date. Historically, the prices for bonds established in the futures markets have tended to move generally in the aggregate in concert with the cash market prices and have maintained fairly predictable relationships. Accordingly, a Fund may use interest rate futures contracts as a defense, or hedge, against anticipated interest rate changes. A Fund presently could accomplish a similar result to that which it hopes to achieve through the use of interest rate futures contracts by selling bonds with long maturities and investing in bonds with short maturities when interest rates are expected to increase, or conversely, selling bonds with short maturities and investing in bonds with long maturities when interest rates are expected to decline. However, because of the liquidity that is often available in the futures market, the protection is more likely to be achieved, perhaps at a lower cost and without changing the rate of interest being earned by a Fund, through using futures contracts.

Interest rate futures contracts are traded in an auction environment on the floors of several exchanges principally, the Chicago Board of Trade, the Chicago Mercantile Exchange and the New York Futures Exchange. Each exchange guarantees performance under contract provisions through a clearing corporation, a nonprofit organization managed by the exchange membership. A public market exists in futures contracts covering various financial instruments including long-term U.S. Treasury Bonds and Notes; GNMA modified pass-through mortgage backed securities; three-month U.S. Treasury Bills; and ninety-day commercial paper. A Fund may also invest in exchange-traded Eurodollar contracts, which are interest rate futures on the forward level of LIBOR. These contracts are generally considered liquid securities and trade on the Chicago Mercantile Exchange. Such Eurodollar contracts are generally used to “lock-in” or hedge the future level of short-term rates. A Fund may trade in any interest rate futures contracts for which there exists a public market, including, without limitation, the foregoing instruments.

Index Futures Contracts. An index futures contract is a contract to buy or sell units of an index at a specified future date at a price agreed upon when the contract is made. Entering into a contract to buy units of an index is commonly referred to as buying or purchasing a contract or holding a long position in the index. Entering into a contract to sell units of an index is commonly referred to as selling a contract or holding a short position in the index. A unit is the current value of the index. A Fund may enter into stock index futures contracts, debt index futures contracts, or other index futures contracts appropriate to its objective(s).

There are several risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. One risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged.

Municipal Bond Index Futures Contracts. Municipal bond index futures contracts may act as a hedge against changes in market conditions. A municipal bond index assigns values daily to the municipal bonds included in the index based on the independent assessment of dealer-to-dealer municipal bond brokers. A municipal bond index futures contract represents a firm commitment by which two parties agree to take or make delivery of an amount equal to a specified dollar amount multiplied by the difference between the municipal bond index value on the last trading date of the contract and the price at which the futures contract is originally struck. No physical delivery of the underlying securities in the index is made.

Options on Futures Contracts. A Fund may purchase and write call and put options on those futures contracts that it is permitted to buy or sell. A Fund may use such options on futures contracts in lieu of writing options directly on the underlying securities or other assets or purchasing and selling the underlying futures contracts. Such options generally operate in the same manner as options purchased or written directly on the underlying investments. A futures option gives the holder, in return for the premium paid, the right to buy from (call) or sell to (put) the writer of the option a futures contract at a specified price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise, the writer of the option is obligated to pay the difference between the cash value of the

 

29


Table of Contents

futures contract and the exercise price. Like the buyer or seller of a futures contract, the holder or writer of an option has the right to terminate its position prior to the scheduled expiration of the option by selling or purchasing an option of the same series, at which time the person entering into the closing purchase transaction will realize a gain or loss. There is no guarantee that such closing purchase transactions can be effected.

A Fund will enter into written options on futures contracts only when, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities equal in value to the underlying security’s or other asset’s value (less any applicable margin deposits) have been deposited in a segregated account. A Fund will be required to deposit initial margin and maintenance margin with respect to put and call options on futures contracts written by it pursuant to brokers’ requirements similar to those described above.

Investments in futures options involve some of the same risks that are involved in connection with investments in futures contracts (for example, the existence of a liquid secondary market). In addition, the purchase of an option also entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option purchased. There may be circumstances when the purchase of a call or put option on a futures contract would result in a loss to a Fund when the purchase or sale of a futures contract would not, such as when there is no movement in the prices of the hedged investments. In general, the market prices of options can be expected to be more volatile than the market prices on the underlying futures contracts. Compared to the purchase or sale of futures contracts, however, the purchase of call or put options on futures contracts may frequently involve less potential risk to a Fund because the maximum amount at risk is the premium paid for the options (plus transaction costs).

Successful use of index futures by a Fund is also subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of the market. It is possible that, for example, where a Fund has sold futures to hedge its portfolio against a decline in the market, the index on which the futures are written may advance and the value of securities held in a Fund’s portfolio may decline. If this occurred, a Fund would lose money on the futures and also experience a decline in the value of its portfolio securities, as a Fund’s ability to effectively hedge all or a portion of the securities in its portfolio, in anticipation of or during a market decline, through transactions in futures or put options on stock indices, depends on the degree to which price movements in the underlying index correlate with the price movements of the securities held by a Fund. Inasmuch as a Fund’s securities will not duplicate the components of an index, the correlation will not be perfect. Consequently, a Fund bears the risk that the prices of its securities being hedged will not move to the same extent as do the prices of its put options on the stock indices. It is also possible that, if a Fund has hedged against the possibility of a decline in the market adversely affecting securities held in its portfolio and securities prices increase instead, a Fund will lose part or all of the benefit of the increased values of those securities that it has hedged, because it will have offsetting losses in its futures positions. In addition, in such situations, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell securities to meet daily variation margin requirements.

In addition to the possibility that there may be an imperfect correlation, or no correlation at all, between movements in the index futures and the securities of the portfolio being hedged, the prices of index futures may not correlate perfectly with movements in the underlying index due to certain market distortions. First, all participants in the futures markets are subject to margin deposit and maintenance requirements. Rather than meeting additional margin deposit requirements, investors may close futures contracts through offsetting transactions, which would distort the normal relationship between the index and futures markets. Second, margin requirements in the futures market are less onerous than margin requirements in the securities market, and as a result, the futures market may attract more speculators than the securities market. Increased participation by speculators in the futures market may also cause temporary price distortions. Due to the possibility of price distortions in the futures market, and also because of the imperfect correlation between movements in an index and movements in the prices of index futures, even a correct forecast of general market trends by the Adviser may still not result in a successful hedging transaction.

There is also the risk of loss by a Fund of margin deposits in the event of bankruptcy of a broker with whom a Fund has an open position in a futures contract or related option. Most futures exchanges limit the amount of

 

30


Table of Contents

fluctuation permitted in some contract prices during a single trading day. The daily limit establishes the maximum amount that the price of a futures contract may vary either up or down from the previous day’s settlement price at the end of a trading session. Once the daily limit has been reached in a particular type of contract, no trades may be made on that day at a price beyond that limit. The daily limit governs only price movement during a particular trading day and, therefore, does not limit potential losses, because the limit may prevent the liquidation of unfavorable positions. Futures contract prices have occasionally moved to the daily limit for several consecutive trading days with little or no trading, thereby preventing prompt liquidation of futures positions and subjecting some futures traders to substantial losses.

Options on Index Futures Contracts. A Fund may also purchase and sell options on index futures contracts. Options on index futures give the purchaser the right, in return for the premium paid, to assume a position in an index futures contract (a long position if the option is a call and a short position if the option is a put), at a specified exercise price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise of the option, the delivery of the futures position by the writer of the option to the holder of the option will be accompanied by delivery of the accumulated balance in the writer’s futures margin account, which represents the amount by which the market price of the index futures contract, at exercise, exceeds (in the case of a call) or is less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option on the index future. If an option is exercised on the last trading day prior to the expiration date of the option, the settlement will be made entirely in cash equal to the difference between the exercise price of the option and the closing level of the index on which the future is based on the expiration date. Purchasers of options who fail to exercise their options prior to the exercise date suffer a loss of the premium paid.

There are various risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. For example, a risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged; there can be no assurance that the Adviser will be successful in doing so.

Use by Tax-Exempt Funds of Interest Rate and U.S. Treasury Security Futures Contracts and Options. If a Fund invests in tax-exempt securities, it may purchase and sell futures contracts and related options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities when, in the opinion of the Adviser, price movements in these security futures and related options will correlate closely with price movements in the tax-exempt securities which are the subject of the hedge. Interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities futures contracts require the seller to deliver, or the purchaser to take delivery of, the type of security called for in the contract at a specified date and price. Options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts give the purchaser the right in return for the premium paid to assume a position in a futures contract at the specified option exercise price at any time during the period of the option.

In addition to the risks generally involved in using futures contracts, there is also a risk that price movements in interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts and related options will not correlate closely with price movements in markets for tax-exempt securities.

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

A Fund may purchase and write (i.e., sell) put and call options. Such options may relate to particular stocks or stock indices, and may or may not be listed on a domestic or foreign securities exchange and may or may not be issued by the Options Clearing Corporation (OCC). Stock index options are put options and call options on various stock indices. In most respects, they are identical to listed options on common stocks.

There is a key difference between stock options and stock index options in connection with their exercise. In the case of stock options, the underlying security, common stock, is delivered. However, upon the exercise of an

 

31


Table of Contents

index option, settlement does not occur by delivery of the securities comprising the index. The option holder who exercises the index option receives an amount of cash if the closing level of the stock index upon which the option is based is greater than (in the case of a call) or less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option. This amount of cash is equal to the difference between the closing price of the stock index and the exercise price of the option expressed in dollars times a specified multiple. A stock index fluctuates with changes in the market value of the securities included in the index. For example, some stock index options are based on a broad market index, such as the S&P 500® Index or a narrower market index, such as the S&P 100® Index. Indices may also be based on an industry or market segment.

The successful use of a Fund’s options strategies depends on the ability of the Adviser to forecast interest rate and market movements correctly. When it purchases an option, a Fund runs the risk that it will lose its entire investment in the option in a relatively short period of time, unless a Fund exercises the option or enters into a closing sale transaction for such option during the life of the option. If the price of the underlying security does not rise (in the case of a call) or fall (in the case of a put) to an extent sufficient to cover the option premium and transaction costs, a Fund will lose part or all of its investment in the option. This contrasts with an investment by a Fund in the underlying securities, since a Fund may continue to hold its investment in those securities notwithstanding the lack of a change in price of those securities.

The effective use of options also depends on a Fund’s ability to terminate option positions at times when the Adviser deems it desirable to do so. Although a Fund will take an option position only if the Adviser believes there is a liquid secondary market for the option, there is no assurance that a Fund will be able to effect closing transactions at any particular time or at an acceptable price.

If a secondary trading market in options were to become unavailable, a Fund could no longer engage in closing transactions. The writer in such circumstances would be subject to the risk of market decline or appreciation in the instrument during such period. If an option purchased by a Fund expires unexercised, a Fund will realize a loss equal to the premium paid. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain options; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions or closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of options, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series of options), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of options) would cease to exist, although outstanding options on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying options purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on the options. If trading is interrupted in an underlying security, the trading of options on that security is normally halted as well. As a result, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be unable to close out its positions until options trading resumes, and it may be faced with losses if trading in the security reopens at a substantially different price. In addition, the OCC or other options markets may impose exercise restrictions. If a prohibition on exercise is imposed at a time when trading in the option has also been halted, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be locked into its position until one of the two restrictions has been lifted. If a prohibition on exercise remains in effect until an option owned by a Fund has expired, a Fund could lose the entire value of its option.

Special risks are presented by internationally traded options. Because of time differences between the United States and various foreign countries, and because different holidays are observed in different countries, foreign options markets may be open for trading during hours or on days when U.S. markets are closed. As a result, option premiums may not reflect the current prices of the underlying interest in the United States.

 

32


Table of Contents

 

Dealer (Over-the-Counter) Options. Dealer options are options negotiated individually through dealers rather than traded on an exchange. Certain risks are specific to dealer options. While a Fund might look to a clearing corporation to exercise exchange-traded options, if a Fund purchases a dealer option it must rely on the selling dealer to perform if a Fund exercises the option. Failure by the dealer to do so would result in the loss of the premium paid by a Fund as well as loss of the expected benefit of the transaction. Exchange-traded options generally have a continuous liquid market while dealer options more often may not. Consequently, a Fund can realize the value of a dealer option it has purchased only by exercising or reselling the option to the issuing dealer. Similarly, when a Fund writes a dealer option, a Fund can close out the option prior to its expiration only by entering into a closing purchase transaction with the dealer. While each Fund seeks to enter into dealer options only with dealers who will agree to and can enter into closing transactions with a Fund, no assurance exists that a Fund will at any time be able to liquidate a dealer option at a favorable price at any time prior to expiration. Unless a Fund, as a covered dealer call option writer, can effect a closing purchase transaction, it will not be able to liquidate securities (or other assets) used as cover until the option expires or is exercised. In the event of insolvency of the other party, a Fund may be unable to liquidate a dealer option. With respect to options written by a Fund, the inability to enter into a closing transaction may result in material losses to a Fund. For example, because a Fund must maintain a secured position with respect to any call option on a security it writes, a Fund may not sell the assets, that it has segregated to secure the position while it is obligated under the option. This requirement may impair a Fund’s ability to sell portfolio securities at a time when such sale might be advantageous.

A Fund generally will treat purchased dealer options as illiquid securities. A Fund may treat the cover used for written dealer options as liquid if the dealer agrees that a Fund may repurchase the dealer option it has written for a maximum price to be calculated by a predetermined formula. In such cases, the dealer option would be considered illiquid only to the extent the maximum purchase price under the formula exceeds the intrinsic value of the option.

Writing Covered Options. A Fund may write covered call options and covered put options on securities held in its portfolio when, in the opinion of the Adviser, such transactions are consistent with a Fund’s investment goal and policies. Call options written by a Fund give the purchaser the right to buy the underlying securities from a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price; put options give the purchaser the right to sell the underlying securities to a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price.

A Fund may write only covered options, which means that, so long as a Fund is obligated as the writer of a call option, it will own the underlying securities subject to the option (or comparable securities satisfying the cover requirements of securities exchanges). In the case of put options, a Fund will hold cash and/or high-grade short-term debt obligations equal to the price to be paid if the option is exercised. In addition, a Fund will be considered to have covered a put or call option if and to the extent that it holds an option that offsets some or all of the risk of the option it has written. A Fund may write combinations of covered puts and calls (straddles) on the same underlying security.

A Fund will receive a premium from writing a put or call option, which increases a Fund’s return on the underlying security if the option expires unexercised or is closed out at a profit. The amount of the premium reflects, among other things, the relationship between the exercise price and the current market value of the underlying security, the volatility of the underlying security, the amount of time remaining until expiration, current interest rates, and the effect of supply and demand in the options market and in the market for the underlying security. By writing a call option, a Fund limits its opportunity to profit from any increase in the market value of the underlying security above the exercise price of the option but continues to bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security. By writing a put option, a Fund assumes the risk that it may be required to purchase the underlying security for an exercise price higher than the security’s then-current market value, resulting in a potential capital loss unless the security subsequently appreciates in value.

 

33


Table of Contents

 

A Fund’s obligation to sell an instrument subject to a call option written by it, or to purchase an instrument subject to a put option written by it, may be terminated prior to the expiration date of the option by a Fund’s execution of a closing purchase transaction, which is effected by purchasing on an exchange an offsetting option of the same series (i.e., same underlying instrument, exercise price and expiration date) as the option previously written. A closing purchase transaction will ordinarily be effected in order to realize a profit on an outstanding option, to prevent an underlying instrument from being called, to permit the sale of the underlying instrument or to permit the writing of a new option containing different terms on such underlying instrument. A Fund realizes a profit or loss from a closing purchase transaction if the cost of the transaction (option premium plus transaction costs) is less or more than the premium received from writing the option. Because increases in the market price of a call option generally reflect increases in the market price of the security underlying the option, any loss resulting from a closing purchase transaction may be offset in whole or in part by unrealized appreciation of the underlying security.

If a Fund writes a call option but does not own the underlying security, and when it writes a put option, a Fund may be required to deposit cash or securities with its broker as “margin” or collateral for its obligation to buy or sell the underlying security. As the value of the underlying security varies, a Fund may also have to deposit additional margin with the broker. Margin requirements are complex and are fixed by individual brokers, subject to minimum requirements currently imposed by the Federal Reserve Board and by stock exchanges and other self-regulatory organizations.

Purchasing Put Options. A Fund may purchase put options to protect its portfolio holdings in an underlying security against a decline in market value. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the put option since a Fund, as holder of the put option, is able to sell the underlying security at the put exercise price regardless of any decline in the underlying security’s market price. For a put option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must decline sufficiently below the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. By using put options in this manner, a Fund will reduce any profit it might otherwise have realized from appreciation of the underlying security by the premium paid for the put option and by transaction costs.

Purchasing Call Options. A Fund may purchase call options to hedge against an increase in the price of securities that a Fund wants ultimately to buy. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the call option since a Fund, as holder of the call option, is able to buy the underlying security at the exercise price regardless of any increase in the underlying security’s market price. In order for a call option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must rise sufficiently above the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. These costs will reduce any profit a Fund might have realized had it bought the underlying security at the time it purchased the call option.

Over-the-Counter (OTC) Options. A Fund will enter into OTC options transactions only with primary dealers in U.S. Government securities and, in the case of OTC options written by a Fund, only pursuant to agreements that will assure that a Fund will at all times have the right to repurchase the option written by it from the dealer at a specified formula price. A Fund will treat the amount by which such formula price exceeds the amount, if any, by which the option may be “in-the-money” as an illiquid investment. It is the present policy of a Fund not to enter into any OTC option transaction if, as a result, more than 15% (10% in some cases, refer to your Fund’s prospectuses) of a Fund’s net assets would be invested in (i) illiquid investments (determined under the foregoing formula) relating to OTC options written by a Fund, (ii) OTC options purchased by a Fund, (iii) securities which are not readily marketable, and (iv) repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days.

Index Options. As an alternative to purchasing call and put options on index futures, a Fund may purchase call and put options on the underlying indices themselves. Such options could be used in a manner identical to the use of options on index futures. Options involving securities indices provide the holder with the right to make or receive a cash settlement upon exercise of the option based on movements in the relevant index. Such options must be listed on a national securities exchange and issued by the OCC. Such options may relate to particular securities or to various stock indices, except that a Fund may not write covered options on an index.

 

34


Table of Contents

 

Foreign Stock Index Options. A Fund may, for the purpose of hedging its portfolio, subject to applicable securities regulations, purchase and write put and call options on foreign stock indices listed on foreign and domestic stock exchanges.

Swap Agreements

Swap agreements are derivative instruments that can be individually negotiated and structured to include exposure to a variety of different types of investments or market factors. Depending on their structure, swap agreements may increase or decrease a Fund’s exposure to long- or short-term interest rates, foreign currency values, mortgage securities, corporate borrowing rates, or other factors such as security prices or inflation rates. A Fund may enter into a variety of swap agreements, including interest rate, index, commodity, equity, credit default and currency exchange rate swap agreements, and other types of swap agreements such as caps, collars and floors. A Fund also may enter into swaptions, which are options to enter into a swap agreement.

In a typical interest rate swap, one party agrees to make regular payments equal to a floating interest rate times a “notional principal amount,” in return for payments equal to a fixed rate times the same amount, for a specified period of time. If a swap agreement provides for payments in different currencies, the parties might agree to exchange notional principal amount as well. In a total return swap agreement, the non-floating rate side of the swap is based on the total return of an individual security, a basket of securities, an index or another reference asset. Swaps may also depend on other prices or rates, such as the value of an index or mortgage prepayment rates.

In a typical cap or floor agreement, one party agrees to make payments only under specified circumstances, usually in return for payment of a fee by the other party. For example, the buyer of an interest rate cap obtains the right to receive payments to the extent that a specified interest rate exceeds an agreed-upon level, while the seller of an interest rate floor is obligated to make payments to the extent that a specified interest rate falls below an agreed-upon level. Caps and floors have an effect similar to buying or writing options. A collar combines elements of buying a cap and selling a floor.

Swap agreements will tend to shift a Fund’s investment exposure from one type of investment to another. For example, if a Fund agreed to pay fixed rates in exchange for floating rates while holding fixed-rate bonds, the swap would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to long-term interest rates. Another example is if a Fund agreed to exchange payments in dollars for payments in foreign currency, the swap agreement would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to U.S. interest rates and increase its exposure to foreign currency and interest rates.

Swap agreements are sophisticated hedging instruments that typically involve a small investment of cash relative to the magnitude of risks assumed. As a result, swaps can be highly volatile and may have a considerable impact on a Fund’s performance. Depending on how they are used, swap agreements may increase or decrease the overall volatility of a Fund’s investments and its share price and yield. Additionally, whether a Fund’s use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment objective will depend on the Adviser’s ability correctly to predict whether certain types of investments likely are to produce greater returns than other investments. Because they are two party contracts and because they may have terms of greater than seven days, swap agreements may be considered to be illiquid. Moreover, a Fund bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. The most significant factor in the performance of swap agreements is the change in the specific interest rate, currency, or other factor that determines the amounts of payments due to and from a Fund. If a swap agreement calls for payments by a Fund, a Fund must be prepared to make such payments when due. In addition, if the counterparty’s creditworthiness declines, the value of a swap agreement likely would decline, potentially resulting in losses for a Fund. A Fund will closely monitor the credit of a swap agreement counterparty in order to attempt to minimize this risk. A Fund may also suffer losses if it is unable to terminate outstanding swap agreements (either by assignment or other disposition) or reduce its exposure through offsetting transactions (i.e., by entering into an offsetting swap agreement with the same party or a similarly creditworthy party).

 

35


Table of Contents

 

Credit Default Swap Agreements. A Fund may enter into credit default swap agreements, which may have as reference obligations one or more securities or a basket of securities that are or are not currently held by a Fund. The protection “buyer” in a credit default contract is generally obligated to pay the protection “seller” an upfront or a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract provided that no credit event, such as a default, on a reference obligation has occurred. If a credit event occurs, the seller generally must pay the buyer the “par value” (full notional value) of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity described in the swap, or the seller may be required to deliver the related net cash amount, if the swap is cash settled. A Fund may be either the buyer or seller in the transaction. If a Fund is a buyer and no credit event occurs, a Fund may recover nothing if the swap is held through its termination date. However, if a credit event occurs, the buyer generally may elect to receive the full notional value of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity whose value may have significantly decreased. As a seller, a Fund generally receives an upfront payment or a fixed rate of income throughout the term of the swap provided that there is no credit event. As the seller, a Fund would effectively add leverage to its portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Credit default swap agreements may involve greater risks than if a Fund had invested in the reference obligation directly since, in addition to risks relating to the reference obligation, credit default swaps are subject to illiquidity risk, counterparty risk and credit risk. A Fund will enter into credit default swap agreements generally with counterparties that meet certain standards of creditworthiness. A buyer generally will lose its investment and recover nothing if no credit event occurs and the swap is held to its termination date. If a credit event were to occur, the value of any deliverable obligation received by the seller, coupled with the upfront or periodic payments previously received, may be less than the full notional value it pays to the buyer, resulting in a loss of value to the seller.

Equity Swaps. A Fund may engage in equity swaps. Equity swaps allow the parties to the swap agreement to exchange components of return on one equity investment (e.g., a basket of equity securities or an index) for a component of return on another non-equity or equity investment, including an exchange of differential rates of return. Equity swaps may be used to invest in a market without owning or taking physical custody of securities in circumstances where direct investment may be restricted for legal reasons or is otherwise impractical. Equity swaps also may be used for other purposes, such as hedging or seeking to increase total return.

The values of equity swaps can be very volatile. To the extent that the Adviser does not accurately analyze and predict the potential relative fluctuation on the components swapped with the other party, a Fund may suffer a loss. The value of some components of an equity swap (such as the dividend on a common stock) may also be sensitive to changes in interest rates. Furthermore, during the period a swap is outstanding, a Fund may suffer a loss if the counterparty defaults.

Total Return Swap Agreements. Total return swap agreements are contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in market value of the assets underlying the contract, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or securities indices during the specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate or the total return from other underlying assets. Total return swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Total return swap agreements may effectively add leverage to a Fund’s portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Total return swap agreements are subject to the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations to a Fund thereunder, and conversely, that a Fund will not be able to meet its obligation to the counterparty. Generally, a Fund will enter into total return swaps on a net basis (i.e., the two payment streams are netted against one another with a Fund receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments). The net amount of the excess, if any, of a Fund’s obligations over its entitlements with respect to each

 

36


Table of Contents

total return swap will be accrued on a daily basis, and an amount of liquid assets having an aggregate net asset value at least equal to the accrued excess will be segregated by a Fund. If the total return swap transaction is entered into on other than a net basis, the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be accrued on a daily basis, and the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be segregated by a Fund in an amount equal to or greater than the market value of the liabilities under the total return swap agreement or the amount it would have cost a Fund initially to make an equivalent direct investment, plus or minus any amount a Fund is obligated to pay or is to receive under the total return swap agreement.

Variance, Volatility and Correlation Swap Agreements. Variance and volatility swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the volatility of certain referenced assets. Correlation swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the correlation between the prices of different assets or different market rates.

Dollar Rolls

Dollar rolls involve selling securities (e.g., mortgage-backed securities or U.S. Treasury securities) and simultaneously entering into a commitment to purchase those or similar (same collateral type, coupon and maturity) securities on a specified future date and price. Mortgage dollar rolls and U.S. Treasury rolls are types of dollar rolls. A Fund foregoes principal and interest paid on the securities during the “roll” period. A Fund is compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the lower forward price for the future purchase of the securities as well as the interest earned on the cash proceeds of the initial sale.

Dollar rolls involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase may decline below the repurchase price or that the transaction costs may exceed the return earned by a Fund from the transaction. Dollar rolls also involve risk to a Fund if the other party should default on its obligation and a Fund is delayed or prevented from completing the transaction. In the event that the buyer of securities under a dollar roll files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the dollar roll may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, the security to be delivered in the future may turn out to be inferior to the security sold upon entering into the transaction.

Foreign Currency Transactions

Foreign currency transactions may be used to protect, to some extent, against uncertainty in the level of future currency exchange rates by establishing a fixed exchange rate. Foreign currency transactions may involve the purchase or sale of foreign currencies on a “spot” (cash) basis at the prevailing exchange rate or may involve “forward contracts” that allow a Fund to purchase or sell foreign currencies at a future date. Forward contracts may be used for “transaction hedging,” “position hedging” and “cross-hedging.” A Fund may use forward sale contracts to sell an amount of a foreign currency approximating the value of a Fund’s securities denominated in the foreign security when that foreign currency suffers a substantial decline against the U.S. dollar. A Fund may use forward purchase contracts to purchase a foreign currency when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a substantial decline against the foreign currency. Although these transactions tend to minimize the risk of loss due to a decline in the value of the hedged currency, they also tend to limit any potential gain that might be realized if the value of the hedged currency increases.

Transaction hedging may allow a Fund to “lock in” the U.S. dollar price of a security it has agreed to purchase or sell, or the U.S. dollar equivalent of a dividend or interest rate payment in a foreign currency. A Fund may use transaction hedging to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currency during the period between the date on which the security is purchased or sold, or on which the dividend or interest payment is declared, and the date on which such payments are made or received.

 

37


Table of Contents

 

Position hedging may allow a Fund to protect against an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currencies in which its portfolio securities are denominated. A Fund may use position hedging when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a decline against the foreign currency by entering into a forward purchase contract to purchase that foreign currency for a fixed dollar amount.

Cross-hedging may allow a Fund to enter into a forward contract to sell a different foreign currency for a fixed U.S. dollar amount when it is believed that the U.S. dollar value of the currency to be sold pursuant to the forward contract will fall if there is a decline in the U.S. dollar value of the currency in which a Fund’s securities are denominated.

A Fund also may purchase exchange-listed and over-the-counter call and put options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts. Options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts give the holder a right to buy or sell the underlying foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts for a specified period of time and for a specified amount. The value of an option on foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts reflects the value of an exchange rate, which depends on the relative values of the U.S. dollar and the relevant foreign currency.

Engaging in foreign currency transactions is subject to certain risks. For example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the dollar value of any securities held by a Fund denominated in that currency. It is impossible to forecast with precision the market value of portfolio securities at the expiration or maturity of a forward or futures contract, which may make it necessary for a Fund to purchase additional foreign currency on the spot market if the market value of the security being hedged is less than the amount of foreign currency a Fund is obligated to deliver at the time a Fund sells the security being hedged. The value of any currency, including the U.S. dollar, may be affected by political and economic factors applicable to the issuer’s country. The exchange rates of currencies also may be affected adversely by governmental actions. Transaction, position and cross-hedging do not eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of securities that a Fund owns or intends to purchase or sell and may limit the amount of potential gain that might result from the increase in value of the currency being hedged. Settlement procedures relating to a Fund’s foreign currency transactions may be more complex than those relating to investments in securities of U.S. issuers.

Foreign Securities

Foreign securities include debt, equity and derivative securities that the Adviser determines are “foreign” based on the consideration of an issuer’s domicile, its principal place of business, its primary stock exchange listing, the source of its revenue or other factors. Foreign securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Foreign securities may include depositary receipts, such as American Depositary Receipts (ADRs), European Depositary Receipts (EDRs) and Global Depositary Receipts (GDRs). ADRs are U.S. dollar denominated receipts issued in registered form by a domestic bank or trust company that evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by a foreign issuer. EDRs are foreign currency-denominated receipts issued in Europe, typically by foreign banks or trust companies and foreign branches of domestic banks, that evidence ownership of foreign or domestic securities. GDRs are receipts structured similarly to ADRs and EDRs and are marketed globally. Depositary receipts will not necessarily be denominated in the same currency as their underlying securities. In general, ADRs, in registered form, are designed for use in the U.S. securities markets, and EDRs, in bearer form, are designed for use in European securities markets. GDRs are tradable both in the United States and in Europe and are designed for use throughout the world. A Fund may invest in depositary receipts through “sponsored” or “unsponsored” facilities. A sponsored facility is established jointly by the issuer

 

38


Table of Contents

of the underlying security and a depositary, whereas a depositary may establish an unsponsored facility without participation by the issuer of the deposited security. Holders of unsponsored depositary receipts generally bear all the costs of such facilities and the depositary of an unsponsored facility frequently is under no obligation to distribute interest holder communications received from the issuer of the deposited security or to pass through voting rights to the holders of such receipts in respect of the deposited securities. The issuers of unsponsored depositary receipts are not obligated to disclose material information in the United States, and, therefore, there may be limited information available regarding such issuers and/or limited correlation between available information and the market value of the depositary receipts.

Due to the potential for foreign withholding taxes, Morgan Stanley Capital International (MSCI) publishes two versions of its indices reflecting the reinvestment of dividends using two different methodologies: gross dividends and net dividends. While both versions reflect reinvested dividends, they differ with respect to the manner in which taxes associated with dividend payments are treated. In calculating the net dividends version, MSCI incorporates reinvested dividends applying the withholding tax rate applicable to foreign non-resident institutional investors that do not benefit from double taxation treaties. The Adviser believes that the net dividends version of MSCI indices better reflects the returns U.S. investors might expect were they to invest directly in the component securities of an MSCI index.

Investing in foreign securities is subject to certain risks. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates also may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies or U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Additionally, the U.S. dollar value of a foreign security tends to decrease when the value of the U.S. dollar rises against the foreign currency in which the security is denominated and tends to increase when the value of the U.S. dollar falls against such currency. A Fund may attempt to minimize the risk from adverse changes in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies by purchasing and selling forward foreign currency exchange contracts and foreign currency futures contracts and related options. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that a Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees also are generally higher for foreign securities. A Fund may have limited legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain debt securities issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which would reduce a Fund’s return on these securities.

Other risks of investing in foreign securities include: possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the notification of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; adverse impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and that foreign companies generally are not subject to accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards comparable to those mandated for domestic companies.

Risks associated with investments in foreign securities are increased with respect to investments in emerging market countries. Political and economic structures in many emerging market countries, especially those in Eastern Europe, the Pacific Basin and the Far East, are undergoing significant evolutionary changes and rapid development, and may lack the social, political and economic stability of more developed countries. Investing in emerging market securities also involves risks beyond the risks applicable to foreign investments. For example, some emerging market countries may have fixed or managed currencies that are not free-floating against the U.S. dollar. Further, certain currencies may not be traded internationally, and some countries with emerging securities markets have sustained long periods of very high inflation or rapid fluctuation in inflation rates which can have negative effects on a country’s economy and securities markets.

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Agreements)

Guaranteed investment contracts, or funding agreements, are debt instruments issued by insurance companies. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of the insurance

 

39


Table of Contents

company’s general account. The insurance company then credits to a Fund payments at negotiated, floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund will purchase guaranteed investment contracts only from issuers that, at the time of purchase, meet certain credit and quality standards.

Investing in guaranteed investment contracts is subject to certain risks. In general, guaranteed investment contracts are not assignable or transferable without the permission of the issuing insurance companies, and an active secondary market does not exist for these investments. In addition, the issuer may not be able to pay the principal amount to a Fund on seven days notice or less, at which time the investment may be considered illiquid under applicable SEC regulatory guidance and subject to certain restrictions.

Illiquid Securities

Illiquid securities are defined by a Fund consistent with SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is an asset which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which a Fund has valued the investment on its books. Some securities, such as those not registered under U.S. securities laws, cannot be sold in public transactions. Subject to its investment policies, a Fund may invest in illiquid investments and may invest in certain restricted securities that are deemed to be illiquid securities.

Initial Public Offerings

A Fund may invest in initial public offerings (IPOs) of common stock or other primary or secondary syndicated offerings of equity or debt securities issued by a corporate issuer. Fixed income funds frequently invest in these types of offerings of debt securities. A purchase of IPO securities often involves higher transaction costs than those associated with the purchase of securities already traded on exchanges or markets. IPO securities are subject to market risk and liquidity risk. The market value of recently issued IPO securities may fluctuate considerably due to factors such as the absence of a prior public market, unseasoned trading and speculation, a potentially small number of securities available for trading, limited information about the issuer, and other factors. A Fund may hold IPO securities for a period of time, or may sell them soon after the purchase. Investments in IPOs could have a magnified impact — either positive or negative — on a Fund’s performance while the Fund’s assets are relatively small. The impact of an IPO on a Fund’s performance may tend to diminish as the Fund’s assets grow. In circumstances when investments in IPOs make a significant contribution to a Fund’s performance, there can be no assurance that similar contributions from IPOs will continue in the future.

Investing in a Master Portfolio

Investing in a Master Portfolio is the way in which the Fund may seek to achieve its investment objective. The 1940 Act permits the Fund, under certain conditions, to invest all of its assets in another mutual fund. Under this structure, called a master/feeder structure, the Fund (the Feeder Fund) invests all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio with the same investment objective, principal investment strategies and risks as the Feeder Fund. The Master Portfolio is a separate series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC, which is organized as a limited liability company under the laws of the State of Delaware, and is itself a registered investment company in the Columbia Funds Family. Other entities (e.g., other investment companies, commingled trust funds, institutional and certain individual investors), along with other Master Portfolios, may invest in the Master Portfolio from time to time. Accordingly, there also may be other investment companies, as well as other investment vehicles, through which you can invest in the Master Portfolio that may have higher or lower fees and expenses than those of the Feeder Fund and that, therefore, may have different performance results than the Feeder Fund.

The primary advantages of the master/feeder structure are potential economies of scale. For example, the larger asset size of the Master Portfolio may allow it to purchase securities and engage in brokerage transactions on more favorable terms than might otherwise be available to the Feeder Fund alone, as well as, over time, to enjoy other benefits associated with achieving economies of scale.

 

40


Table of Contents

 

Investing in a Master Portfolio is subject to certain risks. As with any mutual fund, other investors in the Master Portfolio could control the results of voting at the Master Portfolio level in certain instances (e.g., a change in fundamental policies by the Master Portfolio which was not approved by the Fund’s shareholders). This could cause the Feeder Fund to withdraw its investment in the Master Portfolio. The Feeder Fund also may withdraw its investment in the Master Portfolio at any time if the Board determines that it is in the best interest of the Feeder Fund to do so. Upon such withdrawal, the Board would consider what action should be taken, including the investment of all of the assets of the Feeder Fund in another pooled investment entity having, for example, the same (or similar) investment objective, principal investment strategies and risks as the Feeder Fund or the hiring of an investment adviser to manage the Feeder Fund’s assets in accordance with its investment objective and principal investment strategies. Further, the withdrawal of other entities that may from time to time invest in the Master Portfolio could have an adverse effect on the performance of the Master Portfolio and the Feeder Fund, such as decreased economies of scale and increased per share operating expenses.

Investments in Other Investment Companies

Investing in other investment companies may be a means by which a Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective. A Fund may invest in securities issued by other investment companies within the limits prescribed by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive orders currently or in the future obtained by a Fund from the SEC.

Except with respect to funds structured as funds-of-funds or so-called master/feeder funds, the 1940 Act generally requires that a fund limit its investments in another investment company or series thereof so that, as determined at the time a securities purchase is made: (i) no more than 5% of the value of its total assets will be invested in the securities of any one investment company; (ii) no more than 10% of the value of its total assets will be invested in the aggregate in securities of other investment companies; and (iii) no more than 3% of the outstanding voting stock of any one investment company or series thereof will be owned by a fund or by companies controlled by a fund. Such other investment companies may include ETFs, which are shares of publicly traded unit investment trusts, open-end funds or depositary receipts that seek to track the performance of specific indexes or companies in related industries.

Investing in other investment companies is subject to certain risks. Although a Fund may derive certain advantages from being able to invest in shares of other investment companies, such as to be fully invested, there may be potential disadvantages. Investing in other investment companies may result in higher fees and expenses for a Fund and its shareholders. A shareholder may be charged fees not only on Fund shares held directly but also on the investment company shares that a Fund purchases.

In addition, investing in ETFs is subject to certain other risks. ETFs generally are subject to the same risks as the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track as well as to the risks of the specific sector or industry to which the ETF relates. ETFs also are subject to the risk that their prices may not totally correlate to the prices of the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track and the risk of possible trading halts due to market conditions or for other reasons.

Under the 1940 Act and rules and regulations thereunder, a Fund may purchase shares of affiliated funds, subject to certain conditions. Investing in affiliated funds may present certain actual or potential conflicts of interest. For more information about such actual and potential conflicts of interest, see Investment Advisory and Other Services — Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates — Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

Low and below investment grade securities (below investment grade securities are also known as “junk bonds”) are debt securities with the lowest investment grade rating (e.g., BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by

 

41


Table of Contents

Moody’s), that are below investment grade (e.g., lower than BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by Moody’s) or that are unrated but determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality. These types of securities may be issued to fund corporate transactions or restructurings, such as leveraged buyouts, mergers, acquisitions, debt reclassifications or similar events, are more speculative in nature than securities with higher ratings and tend to be more sensitive to credit risk, particularly during a downturn in the economy. These types of securities generally are issued by unseasoned companies without long track records of sales and earnings, or by companies or municipalities that have questionable credit strength. Low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities: (i) likely will have some quality and protective characteristics that, in the judgment of one or more NRSROs, are outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions; (ii) are speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation; and (iii) may have a less liquid secondary market, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities. Low and below investment grade securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities is subject to certain risks. The rates of return on these types of securities generally are higher than the rates of return available on more highly rated securities, but generally involve greater volatility of price and risk of loss of principal and income, including the possibility of default by or insolvency of the issuers of such securities. Accordingly, a Fund may be more dependent on the Adviser’s credit analysis with respect to these types of securities than is the case for more highly rated securities.

The market values of certain low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities tend to be more sensitive to individual corporate developments and changes in economic conditions than are the market value of more highly rated securities. In addition, issuers of low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities often are highly leveraged and may not have more traditional methods of financing available to them, so that their ability to service their debt obligations during an economic downturn or during sustained periods of rising interest rates may be impaired.

The risk of loss due to default is greater for low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities than it is for higher rated securities because low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities generally are unsecured and frequently are subordinated to more senior indebtedness. A Fund may incur additional expenses to the extent that it is required to seek recovery upon a default in the payment of principal or interest on its holdings of such securities. The existence of limited markets for lower-rated debt securities may diminish a Fund’s ability to: (i) obtain accurate market quotations for purposes of valuing such securities and calculating portfolio net asset value; and (ii) sell the securities at fair market value either to meet redemption requests or to respond to changes in the economy or in financial markets.

Many lower-rated securities are not registered for offer and sale to the public under the 1933Act. Investments in these restricted securities may be determined to be liquid (able to be sold within seven days at approximately the price at which they are valued by a Fund) pursuant to policies approved by the Fund’s Trustees. Investments in illiquid securities, including restricted securities that have not been determined to be liquid, may not exceed 15% of a Fund’s net assets. A Fund is not otherwise subject to any limitation on its ability to invest in restricted securities. Restricted securities may be less liquid than other lower-rated securities, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities.

Money Market Instruments

Money market instruments are high-quality, short-term debt obligations, which include: (i) bank obligations, including certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers’ acceptances; (ii) funding agreements; (iii) repurchase

 

42


Table of Contents

agreements; (iv) obligations of the United States, foreign countries and supranational entities, and each of their subdivisions, agencies and instrumentalities; (v) certain corporate debt securities, such as commercial paper, short-term corporate obligations and extendible commercial notes; (vi) participation interests; and (vii) municipal securities. Money market instruments may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in money market instruments is subject to certain risks. Money market instruments (other than certain U.S. Government obligations) are not backed or insured by the U.S. Government, its agencies or its instrumentalities. Accordingly, only the creditworthiness of an issuer, or guarantees of that issuer, support such instruments.

Mortgage-Backed Securities

Mortgage-backed securities are a type of asset-backed security and represent interests in, or debt instruments backed by, pools of underlying mortgages. In some cases, these underlying mortgages may be insured or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Mortgage-backed securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral (less fees paid to the originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral effectively pass through to such security holders. Mortgage-backed securities are created when mortgage originators (or mortgage loan sellers who have purchased mortgage loans from mortgage loan originators) sell the underlying mortgages to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying mortgage loans, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Mortgage-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Mortgage-backed securities may be issued or guaranteed by GNMA (also known as Ginnie Mae), FNMA (also known as Fannie Mae), or FHLMC (also known as Freddie Mac), but also may be issued or guaranteed by other issuers, including private companies. GNMA is a government-owned corporation that is an agency of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. It guarantees, with the full faith and credit of the United States, full and timely payment of all monthly principal and interest on its mortgage-backed securities. Until recently, FNMA and FHLMC were government-sponsored corporations owned entirely by private stockholders. Both issue mortgage-related securities that contain guarantees as to timely payment of interest and principal but that are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. The value of the companies’ securities fell sharply in 2008 due to concerns that the firms did not have sufficient capital to offset losses. In mid-2008, the U.S. Treasury was authorized to increase the size of home loans that FNMA and FHLMC could purchase in certain residential areas and, until 2009, to lend FNMA and FHLMC emergency funds and to purchase the companies’ stock. In September 2008, the U.S. Treasury announced that FNMA and FHLMC had been placed in conservatorship by the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), a newly created independent regulator. In addition to placing the companies in conservatorship, the U.S. Treasury announced three additional steps that it intended to take with respect to FNMA and FHLMC. First, the U.S. Treasury has entered into “Preferred Stock Purchase Agreements” (PSPAs) under which, if the FHFA determines that FNMA’s or FHLMC’s liabilities have exceeded its assets under generally accepted accounting principles, the U.S. Treasury will contribute cash capital to the company in an amount equal to the difference between liabilities and assets. The PSPAs are designed to provide protection to the senior and subordinated debt and the mortgage-backed securities issued by FNMA and FHLMC. Second, the U.S. Treasury established a new secured lending credit facility that was available to FNMA and FHLMC until December 2009. Third, the U.S. Treasury initiated a temporary program to purchase FNMA

 

43


Table of Contents

and FHLMC mortgage-backed securities that concluded in December 2009. Although the U.S. Government has provided support to FNMA and FHLMC, there can be no assurances that it will support these and other government sponsored enterprises in the future.

CMOs are debt obligations issued by special-purpose trusts, collateralized by underlying mortgage assets. Principal prepayments on underlying mortgage assets may cause the CMOs to be retired substantially earlier than their stated maturities or final distribution dates, resulting in a loss of all or part of the premium if any has been paid. Interest is paid or accrues on all classes of the CMOs on a periodic basis. The principal and interest payments on the underlying mortgage assets may be allocated among the various classes of CMOs in several ways. Typically, payments of principal, including any prepayments, on the underlying mortgage assets are applied to the classes in the order of their respective stated maturities or final distribution dates, so that no payment of principal is made on CMOs of a class until all CMOs of other classes having earlier stated maturities or final distribution dates have been paid in full.

REMICs are entities that own mortgages and elect REMIC status under the Code and, like CMOs, issue debt obligations collateralized by underlying mortgage assets that have characteristics similar to those issued by CMOs.

Investing in mortgage-backed securities is subject to certain risks, including, among others, prepayment, market and credit risks. Prepayment risk reflects the risk that borrowers may prepay their mortgages more quickly than expected, which may affect the security’s average maturity and rate of return. Whether or not a mortgage loan is prepaid is almost entirely controlled by the borrower. Borrowers are most likely to exercise prepayment options at the time when it is least advantageous to investors, generally prepaying mortgages as interest rates fall, and slowing payments as interest rates rise. Besides the effect of prevailing interest rates, the rate of prepayment and refinancing of mortgages also may be affected by home value appreciation, ease of the refinancing process and local economic conditions, among other factors. Market risk reflects the risk that the price of a security may fluctuate over time. The price of mortgage-backed securities can be particularly sensitive to prevailing interest rates, the length of time the security is expected to be outstanding and the liquidity of the issue. In a period of unstable interest rates, there may be decreased demand for certain types of mortgage-backed securities, which in turn may decrease their value. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of mortgage-backed securities may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or the underlying mortgage borrower has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for mortgage-backed securities that are backed by mortgages to so-called subprime borrowers (who may pose a greater risk of defaulting on their loans) or that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of a mortgage-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be. Mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers, whether or not such obligations are subject to guarantees by the private issuer, may entail greater risk than mortgage-backed securities guaranteed by the U.S. Government. The performance of mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers generally depends on the financial health of those institutions.

Municipal Securities

Municipal securities include debt obligations issued by governmental entities to obtain funds for various public purposes, including the construction of a wide range of public facilities, the refunding of outstanding obligations, the payment of general operating expenses, and the extension of loans to public institutions and facilities. Municipal securities can be classified into two principal categories, including “general obligation” bonds and other securities and “revenue” bonds and other securities. General obligation bonds are secured by the issuer’s full faith, credit and taxing power for the payment of principal and interest. Revenue securities are payable only from the revenues derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue source, such as the user of the facility being financed. Municipal securities also may include “moral obligation” securities, which normally are issued by special

 

44


Table of Contents

purpose public authorities. If the issuer of moral obligation securities is unable to meet its debt service obligations from current revenues, it may draw on a reserve fund, the restoration of which is a moral commitment but not a legal obligation of the governmental entity that created the special purpose public authority. Municipal securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Municipal securities may include municipal bonds, municipal notes and municipal leases. Municipal bonds are debt obligations of a governmental entity that obligate the municipality to pay the holder a specified sum of money at specified intervals and to repay the principal amount of the loan at maturity.

Municipal notes may be issued by governmental entities and other tax-exempt issuers in order to finance short-term cash needs or, occasionally, to finance construction. Most municipal notes are general obligations of the issuing entity payable from taxes or designated revenues expected to be received within the relevant fiscal period. Municipal notes generally have maturities of one year or less. Municipal notes can be subdivided into two sub-categories: (i) municipal commercial paper and (ii) municipal demand obligations.

Municipal commercial paper typically consists of very short-term unsecured negotiable promissory notes that are sold, for example, to meet seasonal working capital or interim construction financing needs of a governmental entity or agency. While these obligations are intended to be paid from general revenues or refinanced with long-term debt, they frequently are backed by letters of credit, lending agreements, note repurchase agreements or other credit facility agreements offered by banks or institutions.

Municipal demand obligations can be subdivided into two general types: variable rate demand notes and master demand obligations. Variable rate demand notes are tax-exempt municipal obligations or participation interests that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid on the notes. They permit the holder to demand payment of the notes, or to demand purchase of the notes at a purchase price equal to the unpaid principal balance, plus accrued interest either directly by the issuer or by drawing on a bank letter of credit or guaranty issued with respect to such note. The issuer of the municipal obligation may have a corresponding right to prepay at its discretion the outstanding principal of the note plus accrued interest upon notice comparable to that required for the holder to demand payment. The variable rate demand notes in which a Fund may invest are payable, or are subject to purchase, on demand usually on notice of seven calendar days or less. The terms of the notes generally provide that interest rates are adjustable at intervals ranging from daily to six months.

Master demand obligations are tax-exempt municipal obligations that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid and permit daily changes in the amount borrowed. The interest on such obligations is, in the opinion of counsel for the borrower, excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes (but not necessarily for alternative minimum tax purposes). Although there is no secondary market for master demand obligations, such obligations are considered by a Fund to be liquid because they are payable upon demand.

Municipal lease obligations are participations in privately arranged loans to state or local government borrowers. In general, such loans are unrated, in which case they will be determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality at the time of purchase to rated instruments that may be acquired by a Fund. Frequently, privately arranged loans have variable interest rates and may be backed by a bank letter of credit. In other cases, they may be unsecured or may be secured by assets not easily liquidated. Moreover, such loans in most cases are not backed by the taxing authority of the issuers and may have limited marketability or may be marketable only by virtue of a provision requiring repayment following demand by the lender.

Although lease obligations do not constitute general obligations of the municipal issuer to which the government’s taxing power is pledged, a lease obligation ordinarily is backed by the government’s covenant to

 

45


Table of Contents

budget for, appropriate, and make the payments due under the lease obligation. However, certain lease obligations contain “non-appropriation” clauses that provide that the government has no obligation to make lease or installment purchase payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a periodic basis. In the case of a “non-appropriation” lease, a Fund’s ability to recover under the lease in the event of non-appropriation or default likely will be limited to the repossession of the leased property in the event that foreclosure proves difficult.

Tender option bonds are municipal securities having relatively long maturities and bearing interest at a fixed interest rate substantially higher than prevailing short-term tax-exempt rates that is coupled with the agreement of a third party, such as a bank, broker/dealer or other financial institution, to grant the security holders the option, at periodic intervals, to tender their securities to the institution and receive the face value thereof. The financial institution receives periodic fees equal to the difference between the municipal security’s coupon rate and the rate that would cause the security to trade at face value on the date of determination.

Investing in municipal securities is subject to certain risks. There are variations in the quality of municipal securities, both within a particular classification and between classifications, and the rates of return on municipal securities can depend on a variety of factors, including general money market conditions, the financial condition of the issuer, general conditions of the municipal bond market, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. The ratings of NRSROs represent their opinions as to the quality of municipal securities. It should be emphasized, however, that these ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality, and municipal securities with the same maturity, interest rate, and rating may have different rates of return while municipal securities of the same maturity and interest rate with different ratings may have the same rate of return.

The payment of principal and interest on most municipal securities purchased by a Fund will depend upon the ability of the issuers to meet their obligations. An issuer’s obligations under its municipal securities are subject to the provisions of bankruptcy, insolvency, and other laws affecting the rights and remedies of creditors, such as the United States Bankruptcy Code. The power or ability of an issuer to meet its obligations for the payment of interest on and principal of its municipal securities may be materially adversely affected by litigation or other conditions.

There are particular considerations and risks relevant to investing in a portfolio of a single state’s municipal securities, such as the greater risk of the concentration of portfolio holdings.

The Funds ordinarily purchase municipal securities whose interest, in the opinion of bond counsel, is excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes. The opinion of bond counsel may assert that such interest is not an item of tax preference for the purposes of the alternative minimum tax or is exempt from certain state or local taxes. There is no assurance that the applicable taxing authority will agree with this opinion. In the event, for example, the IRS determines that an issuer does not comply with relevant tax requirements, interest payments from a security could become federally taxable, possibly retroactively to the date the security was issued. As a shareholder of the Fund, you may be required to file an amended tax return as a result, reporting such income as taxable.

For more information about the economic conditions, legal matters and key risks associated with investments in certain states, see Appendix D.

Participation Interests

Participation interests (also called pass-through certificates or securities) represent an interest in a pool of debt obligations, such as municipal bonds or notes, that have been “packaged” by an intermediary, such as a bank or broker/dealer. Participation interests typically are issued by partnerships or trusts through which a Fund receives principal and interest payments that are passed through to the holder of the participation interest from

 

46


Table of Contents

the payments made on the underlying debt obligations. The purchaser of a participation interest receives an undivided interest in the underlying debt obligations. The issuers of the underlying debt obligations make interest and principal payments to the intermediary, as an initial purchaser, which are passed through to purchasers in the secondary market, such as a Fund. Mortgage-backed securities are a common type of participation interest. Participation interests may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in- kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Loan participations also are a type of participation interest. Loan participations are interests in loans that are administered by a lending bank or agent for a syndicate of lending banks and sold by the bank or syndicate members.

Investing in participation interests is subject to certain risks. Participation interests generally are subject to the credit risk associated with the underlying borrowers. If the underlying borrower defaults, a Fund may be subject to delays, expenses and risks that are greater than those that would have been involved if a Fund had purchased a direct obligation of the borrower. A Fund also may be deemed a creditor of the lending bank or syndicate members and be subject to the risk that the lending bank or syndicate members may become insolvent.

Preferred Stock

Preferred stock represents units of ownership of a corporation that frequently have dividends that are set at a specified rate. Preferred stock has preference over common stock in the payment of dividends and the liquidation of assets. Preferred stock shares some of the characteristics of both debt and equity. Preferred stock ordinarily does not carry voting rights. Most preferred stock is cumulative; if dividends are passed (i.e., not paid for any reason), they accumulate and must be paid before common stock dividends. Participating preferred stock entitles its holders to share in profits above and beyond the declared dividend, along with common shareholders, as distinguished from nonparticipating preferred stock, which is limited to the stipulated dividend. Convertible preferred stock is exchangeable for a given number of shares of common stock and thus tends to be more volatile than nonconvertible preferred stock, which generally behaves more like a fixed income bond. Preferred stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Auction preferred stock (APS) is a type of adjustable-rate preferred stock with a dividend determined periodically in a Dutch auction process by corporate bidders. Shares typically are bought and sold at face values generally ranging from $100,000 to $500,000 per share.

In addition to reinvestment risk if interest rates fall, some specific risks with regard to APS include:

 

   

Failed auction: A breakdown of the auction process can occur. In the event that the process fails, the rate is reset at the maximum applicable rate, which is usually described in the prospectuses and typically is influenced by the issuer’s credit rating. In a failed auction, current shareholders generally are unable to sell some, or all, of the shares when the auction is completed. Typically, the liquidity for APS that have experienced a failed auction becomes very limited. If a failed auction were to occur, the shareholder generally would hold his or her shares until the next auction. Should there not be subsequent auctions that “cure” the failed process, the shareholder may: (1) hold the APS in anticipation of a refinancing by the issuer that would cause the APS to be called, or (2) hold securities either indefinitely or in anticipation of the development of a secondary market.

 

   

Early call risk: APS generally is redeemable at any time, usually upon notice, at the issuer’s option, at par plus accrued dividends.

 

47


Table of Contents

 

Investing in preferred stock is subject to certain risks. For example, stock market risk is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when prices generally rise and periods when prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and decline based on factors specific to each corporation, such as changes in earnings or management.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular company. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price fluctuations than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, are more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Stocks of these companies may have a higher potential for gains but also are subject to greater risk of loss.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably affect, an industry, the prices of the stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the value of those companies’ stock to decline.

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

Private placement securities are securities that have been privately placed and are not registered under the 1933 Act. They are eligible for sale only to certain eligible investors. Private placements often may offer attractive opportunities for investment not otherwise available on the open market. Private placement and other “restricted” securities often cannot be sold to the public without registration under the 1933 Act or the availability of an exemption from registration (such as Rules 144 or 144A), or they are “not readily marketable” because they are subject to other legal or contractual delays in or restrictions on resale. Asset-backed securities, common stock, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, preferred stock and other types of equity and debt instruments may be privately placed or restricted securities.

Private placements typically may be sold only to qualified institutional buyers (or, in the case of the initial sale of certain securities, such as those issued in collateralized debt obligations or collateralized loan obligations, to accredited investors (as defined in Rule 501(a) under the 1933 Act), or in a privately negotiated transaction or to a limited number of purchasers, or in limited quantities after they have been held for a specified period of time and other conditions are met pursuant to an exemption from registration.

Investing in private placement and other restricted securities is subject to certain risks. Private placements may be considered illiquid securities. Private placements typically are subject to restrictions on resale as a matter of contract or under federal securities laws. Because there may be relatively few potential purchasers for such securities, especially under adverse market or economic conditions or in the event of adverse changes in the financial condition of the issuer, a Fund could find it more difficult to sell such securities when it may be advisable to do so or it may be able to sell such securities only at prices lower than if such securities were more widely held. At times, it also may be more difficult to determine the fair value of such securities for purposes of computing a Fund’s net asset value due to the absence of a trading market.

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

REITs are entities that either own properties or make construction or mortgage loans and also may include operating or finance companies. An equity REIT generally holds equity positions in real estate and seeks to

 

48


Table of Contents

provide its shareholders with income from the leasing of its properties and with capital gains from any sales of properties. A mortgage REIT generally specializes in lending money to owners of properties and passes through any interest income it may earn to its shareholders.

Partnership units of real estate and other types of companies sometimes are organized as master limited partnerships in which ownership interests are publicly traded. Master limited partnerships often own several properties or businesses (or directly own interests) that are related to real estate development and the oil and gas industries, but they also may finance motion pictures, research and development and other projects.

REITs are subject to certain risks associated with direct ownership of real estate, including, for example, declines in the value of real estate, risks related to general and local economic conditions, overbuilding and increased competition, increases in property taxes and operating expenses, and variations in rental income. REITs also may be subject to interest rate risk. In general, increases in interest rates will decrease the value of high-yield securities and increase the costs of obtaining financing, which could decrease the value of a REIT’s investments. In addition, equity REITs may be affected by changes in the value of the underlying property owned by the REITs, while mortgage REITs may be affected by the quality of credit extended. Both equity and mortgage REITs are dependent upon management skills. REITs also may be subject to heavy cash flow dependency, defaults by borrowers, and the possibility of failing to qualify for preferential tax treatment under the Code, which could adversely affect dividend payments. REITs also may not be diversified.

Investing in master limited partnerships generally is subject to the risks applicable to investing in a partnership as opposed to a corporation, which may include fewer protections afforded to investors. Additional risks include those associated with the specific industries in which a master limited partnership invests, such as the risks associated with investing in the real estate or oil and gas industries.

Repurchase Agreements

Repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund acquires a security for a relatively short period of time subject to the obligation of a seller to repurchase and a Fund to resell such security at a fixed time and price (representing a Fund’s cost plus interest). Repurchase agreements also may be viewed as loans made by a Fund that are collateralized by the securities subject to repurchase. A Fund typically will enter into repurchase agreements only with commercial banks, registered broker/dealers and the Fixed Income Clearing Corporation. Such transactions are monitored to ensure that the value of the underlying securities will be at least equal at all times to the total amount of the repurchase obligation, including any accrued interest. Repurchase agreements generally are subject to counterparty risk.

If a counterparty defaults, a Fund could realize a loss on the sale of the underlying security to the extent that the proceeds of the sale are less than the resale price provided in the repurchase agreement including interest. In the event that a counterparty fails to perform because it is insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund’s right to take possession of the underlying securities would be subject to applicable insolvency law and procedure, including an automatic stay (which would preclude immediate enforcement of a Fund’s rights) and exemptions thereto (which would permit a Fund to take possession of the underlying securities or to void a repurchase agreement altogether). Since it is possible that an exemption from the automatic stay would not be available, a Fund might be prevented from immediately enforcing its rights against the counterparty. Accordingly, if a counterparty becomes insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund may incur delays in or be prevented from liquidating the underlying securities and could experience losses, including the possible decline in value of the underlying securities during the period in which a Fund seeks to enforce its rights thereto, possible subnormal levels of income or lack of access to income during such time, as well as the costs incurred in enforcing a Fund’s rights. For example, if a Fund enters into a repurchase agreement with a broker that becomes insolvent, it is possible for the Securities Investor Protection Corporation (SIPC) to institute a liquidation proceeding in federal court against the broker counterparty which could lead to a foreclosure by SIPC of the underlying securities or SIPC may stay, or preclude, a Fund’s ability under contract to terminate the repurchase agreement.

 

49


Table of Contents

 

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

Reverse repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund sells a security subject to the obligation of a buyer to resell and a Fund to repurchase such security at a fixed time and price. Reverse repurchase agreements also may be viewed as borrowings made by a Fund.

Reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase under the agreement may decline below the repurchase price. In the event the buyer of securities under a reverse repurchase agreement files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the agreement may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, reverse repurchase agreements are techniques involving leverage, and are subject to asset coverage requirements. Under the requirements of the 1940 Act, a Fund is required to maintain an asset coverage (including the proceeds of the borrowings) of at least 300% of all borrowings.

Standby Commitments

Standby commitments are securities under which a purchaser, usually a bank or broker/dealer, agrees to purchase, for a fee, an amount of a Fund’s municipal obligations. The amount payable by a bank or broker/dealer to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment typically will be substantially the same as the value of the underlying municipal securities. A Fund may pay for standby commitments either separately in cash or by paying a higher price for portfolio securities that are acquired subject to such a commitment.

Using standby commitments is subject to certain risks. Standby commitments are subject to the risk that a counterparty will not fulfill its obligation to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment.

Stripped Securities

Stripped securities are securities that evidence ownership in either the future interest or principal payments on an instrument. There are many different types and variations of stripped securities. For example, Separate Trading of Registered Interest and Principal Securities (STRIPS), can be component parts of a U.S. Treasury security where the principal and interest components are traded independently through DTC, a clearing agency registered pursuant to Section 17A of the 1934 Act and created to hold securities for its participants, and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between participants through electronic computerized book-entries, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of certificates. Treasury Investor Growth Receipts (TIGERs) are U.S. Treasury securities stripped by brokers. Stripped mortgage-backed securities, or SMBS, also can be issued by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Stripped securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

SMBS usually are structured with two or more classes that receive different proportions of the interest and principal distributions from a pool of mortgage-backed assets. Common types of SMBS will be structured so that one class receives some of the interest and most of the principal from the mortgage-backed assets, while another class receives most of the interest and the remainder of the principal.

Investing in stripped securities is subject to certain risks. If the underlying obligations experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, a Fund may fail fully to recoup its initial investment in such securities. The market value of the class consisting primarily or entirely of principal payments can be especially volatile in response to changes in interest rates. The rates of return on a class of SMBS that receives all or most of the interest are generally higher than prevailing market rates of return on other mortgage-backed obligations because their cash flow patterns also are volatile and there is a greater risk that the initial investment will not be recouped fully.

 

50


Table of Contents

 

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

U.S. Government obligations include U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government or by various instrumentalities which have been established or sponsored by the U.S. Government. U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government differ in their interest rates, maturities and time of issuance, as well as with respect to whether they are guaranteed by the U.S. Government. U.S. Government and related obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

U.S. Government obligations also include senior unsecured debt securities issued between October 14, 2008 and June 30, 2009 by eligible issuers (including U.S. depository institutions insured by the FDIC (and certain affiliates), U.S. bank holding companies and certain U.S. savings and loan holding companies) that are guaranteed by the FDIC under its Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (the “TLGP”). The FDIC’s guarantee under the TLGP will expire upon the earlier of (i) maturity of such security or (ii) June 30, 2012. It is the view of the FDIC and the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission that any debt security that is guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP and that has a maturity that ends on or before June 30, 2012 would be a security exempt from registration under Section 3(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933 because such security would be fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the FDIC.

Investing in securities guaranteed under the TLGP is subject to certain risks. Given that there is a limited track record for securities guaranteed under the TLGP, it is uncertain whether such securities will continue to trade in line with recent experience in relation to treasury and government agency securities in terms of yield spread and the volatility of such spread and it is uncertain how such securities will trade in the secondary market and whether that market will be liquid or illiquid. The TLGP is a new program that is subject to change. In order to collect from the FDIC under the TLGP, a claims process must be followed. Failure to follow the claims process could result in a loss to the right to payment under the guarantee. In addition, guarantee payments by the FDIC under the TLGP may be delayed.

Investing in U.S. Government and related obligations is subject to certain risks. While U.S. Treasury obligations are backed by the “full faith and credit” of the U.S. Government, securities issued or guaranteed by federal agencies and U.S. Government-sponsored instrumentalities may or may not be backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. These securities may be supported by the ability to borrow from the U.S. Treasury or only by the credit of the issuing agency or instrumentality and, as a result, may be subject to greater credit risk than securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Treasury. Obligations of U.S. Government agencies, authorities, instrumentalities and sponsored enterprises historically have involved limited risk of loss of principal if held to maturity. However, no assurance can be given that the U.S. Government would provide financial support to any of these entities if it is not obligated to do so by law.

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

Variable- and floating-rate obligations provide for periodic adjustments in the interest rate and, under certain circumstances, varying principal amounts. Unlike a fixed interest rate, a variable, or floating, rate is one that rises and declines based on the movement of an underlying index of interest rates and may pay interest at rates that are adjusted periodically according to a specified formula. Asset-backed securities, bank obligations, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as variable- and floating-rate obligations.

Investing in variable- and floating-rate obligations is subject to certain risks. Variable- and floating-rate obligations may involve direct lending arrangements between the purchaser and the issuer and there may be no active secondary market, making it difficult to resell such obligations to a third party. Variable- and floating-rate

 

51


Table of Contents

obligations also may be subject to interest rate and credit risks. Changes in interest rates can affect the rate of return on such obligations. If an issuer of a variable- or floating-rate obligation defaults, a Fund could sustain a loss to the extent of such default.

Warrants and Rights

Warrants and rights are types of securities that give a holder a right to purchase shares of common stock. Warrants usually are issued together with a bond or preferred stock and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock at a specified price typically for a period of years. Rights usually have a specified purchase price that is lower than the current market price and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock typically for a period of only weeks. Warrants may be used to enhance the marketability of a bond or preferred stock.

Warrants and rights may be subject to the risk that the securities could lose value. There also is the risk that the potential exercise price may exceed the market price of the warrants or rights, such as when there is no movement in the market price or the market price of such securities declines.

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the purchase or sale of securities by a Fund, with payment and delivery taking place in the future. When engaging in when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions, a Fund typically will hold cash or liquid securities in a segregated account in an amount equal to or greater than the purchase price. The payment obligation and, if applicable, the interest rate that will be received on the securities, are fixed at the time that a Fund agrees to purchase the securities. A Fund generally will enter into when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions only with the intention of completing such transactions. However, the Adviser may determine not to complete a transaction if it deems it appropriate. In such cases, a Fund may realize short-term gains or losses.

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the risks that the securities purchased may fall in value by the time they actually are issued or that the other party may fail to honor the contract terms. A Fund that invests in delayed delivery securities may rely on a third party to complete the transaction. Failure by a third party to deliver a security purchased on a delayed delivery basis may result in a financial loss to a Fund or the loss of an opportunity to make an alternative investment.

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

Zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities are types of debt instruments that do not necessarily make payments of interest in fixed amounts or at fixed intervals. Asset-backed securities, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities.

Zero-coupon securities do not pay interest on a current basis but instead accrue interest over the life of the security. These securities include, among others, zero-coupon bonds, which either may be issued at a discount by a corporation or government entity or may be created by a brokerage firm when it strips the coupons from a bond or note and then sells the bond or note and the coupon separately. This technique is used frequently with U.S. Treasury bonds, and zero-coupon securities are marketed under such names as CATS (Certificate of Accrual on Treasury Securities), TIGERs or STRIPS. Zero-coupon bonds also are issued by municipalities. Buying a municipal zero-coupon bond frees its purchaser of the obligation to pay regular federal income tax on imputed interest, since the interest is exempt for regular federal income tax purposes. Zero-coupon certificates of deposit and zero-coupon mortgages are generally structured in the same fashion as zero-coupon bonds; the certificate of deposit holder or mortgage holder receives face value at maturity and no payments until then.

 

52


Table of Contents

 

Pay-in-kind securities normally give the issuer an option to pay cash at a coupon payment date or to give the holder of the security a similar security with the same coupon rate and a face value equal to the amount of the coupon payment that would have been made.

Step-coupon securities trade at a discount from their face value and pay coupon interest. The coupon rate is paid according to a schedule for a series of periods, typically lower for an initial period and then increasing to a higher coupon rate thereafter. The discount from the face amount or par value depends on the time remaining until cash payments begin, prevailing interest rates, liquidity of the security and the perceived credit quality of the issue.

Zero-coupon, step-coupon and pay-in-kind securities holders generally have substantially all the rights and privileges of holders of the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations. Holders of these securities have the right upon default on the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations to proceed directly and individually against the issuer and are not required to act in concert with other holders of such securities.

Investing in zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities is subject to certain risks, including that market prices of zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities generally are more volatile than the prices of securities that pay interest periodically and in cash, and are likely to respond to changes in interest rates to a greater degree than other types of debt securities.

Because zero-coupon securities bear no interest, they are volatile. Since zero-coupon bondholders do not receive interest payments, zero-coupon securities fall more dramatically than bonds paying interest on a current basis when interest rates rise. However, when interest rates fall, zero-coupon securities rise more rapidly in value than interest paying bonds.

Borrowings

Each Fund has a fundamental policy with respect to borrowing that can be found under the heading About the Funds’ Investments — Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies. Specifically, each Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds. In general, pursuant to the 1940 Act, a Fund may borrow money only from banks in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings). Any borrowings that come to exceed this amount must be reduced within three days (not including Sundays and holidays) to the extent necessary to comply with the 33 1/3% limitation.

The Funds participate in a committed line of credit (Line of Credit). Any advance under the Line of Credit is contemplated primarily for temporary or emergency purposes, including the meeting of redemption requests that otherwise might require the untimely sale of portfolio securities.

Pursuant to an exemptive order from the SEC, a Fund may, subject to certain conditions, borrow money from or lend money to other funds in the Columbia Funds Family or any other registered investment company advised by the Adviser or its affiliates for temporary emergency purposes in order to facilitate redemption requests, or for other purposes consistent with Fund investment policies and restrictions. All loans are set at an interest rate between the rates charged on overnight repurchase agreements and short-term bank loans.

Short Sales

A Fund may sometimes sell securities short when it owns an equal amount of such securities as those securities sold short. This is a technique known as selling short “against the box.” If a Fund makes a short sale “against the box,” it would not immediately deliver the securities sold and would not receive the proceeds from the sale. The seller is said to have a short position in the securities sold until it delivers the securities sold, at

 

53


Table of Contents

which time it receives the proceeds of the sale. To secure its obligation to deliver securities sold short, a Fund will deposit in escrow in a separate account with the custodian an equal amount of the securities sold short or securities convertible into or exchangeable for such securities. A Fund can close out its short position by purchasing and delivering an equal amount of the securities sold short, rather than by delivering securities already held by a Fund, because a Fund might want to continue to receive interest and dividend payments on securities in its portfolio that are convertible into the securities sold short.

Short sales “against the box” entail many of the same risks and considerations described above regarding short sales not “against the box.” However, when a Fund sells short “against the box” it typically limits the amount of securities that it has leveraged. A Fund’s decision to make a short sale “against the box” may be a technique to hedge against market risks when the Adviser believes that the price of a security may decline, causing a decline in the value of a security owned by a Fund or a security convertible into or exchangeable for such security. In such case, any future losses in a Fund’s long position would be reduced by a gain in the short position. The extent to which such gains or losses in the long position are reduced will depend upon the amount of securities sold short relative to the amount of the securities a Fund owns, either directly or indirectly, and, in the case where a Fund owns convertible securities, changes in the investment values or conversion premiums of such securities. Short sales may have adverse tax consequences to a Fund and its shareholders.

Subject to its fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies, a Fund may engage in short sales that are not “against the box,” which are sales by a Fund of securities or commodity futures contracts that it does not own in hopes of purchasing the same security at a later date at a lower price. The technique is also used to protect a profit in a long-term position in a security or commodity futures contract. To make delivery to the buyer, a Fund must borrow or purchase the security. If borrowed, a Fund is then obligated to replace the security borrowed from the third party, so a Fund must purchase the security at the market price at a later time. If the price of the security has increased during this time, then a Fund will incur a loss equal to the increase in price of the security from the time of the short sale plus any premiums and interest paid to the third party. (Until the security is replaced, a Fund is required to pay to the lender amounts equal to any dividends or interest which accrue during the period of the loan. To borrow the security, a Fund also may be required to pay a premium, which would increase the cost of the security sold. The proceeds of the short sale will be retained by the broker, to the extent necessary to meet the margin requirements, until the short position is closed out.)

Short sales by a Fund that are not made “against the box” create opportunities to increase a Fund’s return but, at the same time, involve specific risk considerations and may be considered a speculative technique. Because a Fund in effect profits from a decline in the price of the securities sold short without the need to invest the full purchase price of the securities on the date of the short sale, a Fund’s NAV per share tends to increase more when the securities it has sold short decrease in value, and to decrease more when the securities it has sold short increase in value, than if it had not engaged in such short sales. The amount of any gain will be decreased, and the amount of any loss increased, by the amount of any premium, dividends or interest a Fund may be required to pay in connection with the short sale. Short sales could potentially involve unlimited loss, as the market price of securities sold short may continually increase, although a Fund can mitigate any such losses by replacing the securities sold short. Under adverse market conditions, a Fund might have difficulty purchasing securities to meet its short sale delivery obligations, and might have to sell portfolio securities to raise the capital necessary to meet its short sale obligations at a time when fundamental investment considerations would not favor such sales. There is also the risk that the third party to the short sale may fail to honor its contract terms, causing a loss to a Fund.

A Fund’s successful use of short sales also will be subject to the ability of the Adviser to predict movements in the directions of the relevant market. A Fund therefore bears the risk that the Adviser will incorrectly predict future price directions. In addition, if a Fund sells a security short, and that security’s price goes up, a Fund will have to make up the margin on its open position (i.e., purchase more securities on the market to cover the position). It may be unable to do so and thus its position may not be closed out. There can be no assurance that a Fund will not incur significant losses in such a case.

 

54


Table of Contents

 

In the view of the SEC, a short sale involves the creation of a “senior security” as such term is defined in the 1940 Act, unless the sale is “against the box” and the securities sold short are placed in a segregated account (not with the broker), or unless a Fund’s obligation to deliver the securities sold short is “covered” by placing in a segregated account (not with the broker) cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities in an amount equal to the difference between the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale and any such collateral required to be deposited with a broker in connection with the sale (not including the proceeds from the short sale), which difference is adjusted daily for changes in the value of the securities sold short. The total value of the cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities deposited with the broker and otherwise segregated may not at any time be less than the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale.

Lending Securities

Securities lending refers to the lending of the Fund’s portfolio securities. Subject to its investment policies described above and in the prospectuses, the Fund may make secured loans of its portfolio securities to broker/dealers and other institutional investors. Securities loans by the Fund are made pursuant to agreements that require that loans be secured continuously by collateral in cash. The Fund retains all or a portion of the income received on investment of cash collateral. A borrower will pay to the Fund an amount equal to any dividends or interest received on securities loaned, but the borrower typically will receive a portion of the income earned on investments of cash collateral. Although voting rights, or rights to consent, with respect to loaned securities pass to a borrower, the Fund retains the right to call the loans at any time on reasonable notice, and may do so in order to vote upon matters affecting, or to sell, the loaned securities.

The Fund typically invests the cash collateral it receives in connection with its securities lending program directly or indirectly in high quality, short-term investments. The Fund may invest some or all of such cash collateral in one or more pooled investment vehicles, including, among other vehicles, money market funds managed by the Fund’s securities lending agent or its affiliates. The securities lending agent shares in any income resulting from the investment of such cash collateral, and an affiliate of the securities lending agent receives asset-based fees for the management of such pooled investment vehicles, which may create a conflict of interest between the securities lending agent (or its affiliate) and the Fund with respect to the management of such cash collateral.

Engaging in securities lending is subject to certain risks, including counterparty risk, which is the risk that the counterparty to a transaction could default. There also is a risk of possible delay in the recovery of loaned securities or possible loss of rights in the collateral if a borrower fails financially.

Portfolio Turnover

A change in the securities held by a Fund is known as “portfolio turnover.” High portfolio turnover (e.g., over 100%) involves correspondingly greater expenses to the Fund, including brokerage commissions or dealer mark-ups and other transaction costs on the sale of securities and reinvestments in other securities. Such sales may also result in adverse tax consequences to a Fund’s shareholders. The trading costs and tax effects associated with portfolio turnover may adversely affect a Fund’s performance.

For each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate, see the Fees and Expenses of the Fund — Portfolio Turnover section in the prospectuses for that Fund.

In any particular year, market conditions may result in greater rates than are presently anticipated. The rate of a Fund’s turnover may vary significantly from time to time depending on the volatility of economic and market conditions.

 

55


Table of Contents

 

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

The Board has adopted policies and procedures with respect to the disclosure of each Fund’s portfolio holdings. These policies and procedures are designed to ensure that disclosure of information regarding a Fund’s portfolio securities is in the best interests of Fund shareholders and to address conflicts between the interests of Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Fund, on the other. These policies and procedures provide that a Fund’s portfolio holdings information generally may not be disclosed to any party prior to the earlier of: (i) the business day next following the posting of such information on the Columbia Funds’ website, if applicable, or (ii) the time a Fund discloses the information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information. Certain limited exceptions that have been approved consistent with the policies and procedures are described below. The Board is updated as needed regarding compliance with these policies and procedures. The policies and procedures prohibit the Adviser and a Fund’s other service providers from entering into any agreement to disclose Fund portfolio holdings information in exchange for any form of consideration. The same policies and procedures apply to all categories of Columbia Funds and include some variations tailored to the different categories of Columbia Funds. Accordingly, some of the provisions described below do not apply to the Columbia Funds covered by this SAI. The Adviser also has adopted policies and procedures to monitor for compliance with these portfolio holdings disclosure policies and procedures.

Public Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings are currently disclosed to the public through required filings with the SEC and on the Columbia Funds’ website. This information is available on the Columbia Funds’ website as described below.

 

   

For equity, convertible, balanced and asset allocation Columbia Funds, other than small cap and specialty Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 15 calendar days after such month-end.

 

   

For small cap and specialty Columbia Funds and those Columbia Funds that are sub-advised by Marsico and Brandes, subadvisers for certain Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such month-end.

 

   

For fixed-income funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a calendar quarter-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such quarter-end.

 

   

For money market funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of month-end are posted on the Columbia Funds’ website on a monthly basis, approximately five business days after such month-end. Commencing with the month-end holdings as of September 2010 and thereafter, such month-end holdings will be continuously available on the website for at least six months, together with a link to an SEC webpage where a user of the website may obtain access to the fund’s most recent 12 months of publicly available filings on Form N-MFP. Additionally, as of September 2010 and thereafter, money market fund portfolio holdings information posted on the website will, at minimum, include with respect to each holding, the name of the issuer, the category of investment (e.g., Treasury debt, government agency debt, asset backed commercial paper, structured investment vehicle note), the CUSIP number (if any), the principal amount, the maturity date (as determined under Rule 2a-7 for purposes of calculating weighted average maturity), the final maturity date (if different from the maturity date previously described), coupon or yield and the amortized cost value. The money market funds will also disclose on the website the overall weighted average maturity and weighted average life maturity of a holding.

The Adviser makes publicly available information regarding certain Columbia Fund’s largest five to fifteen holdings, as a percent of the market value of the Columbia Funds’ portfolios as of a month-end. This holdings information is made publicly available through the website generally no earlier than fifteen (15) days following the month-end.

 

56


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser may also disclose more current portfolio holdings information as of specified dates on the Columbia Funds’ website.

The scope of the information that is made available on the Columbia Funds’ website pursuant to the Columbia Funds’ policies relating to a Columbia Fund’s portfolio may change from time to time without prior notice. The Columbia Funds file their portfolio holdings with the SEC for each fiscal quarter on Form N-CSR (with respect to each annual period and semi-annual period) and Form N-Q (with respect to the first and third quarters of each Columbia Fund’s fiscal year). Shareholders may obtain each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, a link to which is provided on the Columbia Funds’ website. In addition, each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings may be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s public reference room in Washington, D.C. You may call the SEC at 202.551.8090 for information about the SEC’s website or the operation of the public reference room.

The Columbia Funds, the Adviser and their affiliates may include portfolio holdings information that already has been made public through a website posting or SEC filing in marketing literature and other communications to shareholders, advisors or other parties, provided that the information is disclosed no earlier than the business day after the date the information is disclosed publicly on the Columbia Funds’ website or no earlier than the time a Columbia Fund files such information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information.

Other Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ policies and procedures provide that no disclosures of the Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings may be made prior to the portfolio holdings information being made public unless (i) the Columbia Funds have a legitimate business purpose for making such disclosure, (ii) the Columbia Funds’ President authorizes such non-public disclosure of information, and (iii) the party receiving the non-public information enters into an appropriate confidentiality agreement or is otherwise subject to a confidentiality obligation.

In determining the existence of a legitimate business purpose for making portfolio disclosures, the following factors, among others, are considered: (i) any prior disclosure must be consistent with the anti-fraud provisions of the federal securities laws and the fiduciary duties of the Adviser; (ii) any conflicts of interest between the interests of Columbia Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Columbia Fund, on the other; and (iii) any prior disclosure to a third party, although subject to a confidentiality agreement, would not make conduct lawful that otherwise is unlawful.

In addition, the Columbia Funds periodically disclose their portfolio information on a confidential basis to various service providers that require such information to assist the Columbia Funds with their day-to-day business affairs. In addition to the Adviser and its affiliates, these service providers include each Columbia Fund’s subadviser(s) (if any), the Columbia Funds’ custodian, sub-custodians, independent registered public accounting firm, legal counsel, financial printers, proxy solicitor and proxy voting service provider, as well as ratings agencies that maintain ratings on certain Columbia Funds. These service providers are required to keep such information confidential, and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information except as necessary in providing services to the Columbia Funds. The Columbia Funds also may disclose portfolio holdings information to broker/dealers and certain other entities in connection with potential transactions and management of the Columbia Funds, provided that reasonable precautions, including limitations on the scope of the portfolio holdings information disclosed, are taken to avoid any potential misuse of the disclosed information.

Each Columbia Fund’s Board has adopted policies to ensure that the Columbia Fund’s holdings information is only disclosed in accordance with these policies. Before any selective disclosure of holdings information is permitted, the person seeking to disclose such holdings information must submit a written request to the Portfolio Holdings Committee (“PHC”). The PHC is comprised of members from the Adviser’s legal department, the

 

57


Table of Contents

Adviser’s compliance department, and the Columbia Funds’ President. The PHC has been authorized by each Columbia Fund’s Board to perform an initial review of requests for disclosure of holdings information to evaluate whether there is a legitimate business purpose for selective disclosure, whether selective disclosure is in the best interests of a fund and its shareholders, to consider any potential conflicts of interest between the fund, the investment adviser, and its affiliates, and to safeguard against improper use of holdings information. Factors considered in this analysis are whether the recipient has agreed to or has a duty to keep the holdings information confidential and whether risks have been mitigated such that the recipient has agreed or has a duty to use the holdings information only as necessary to effectuate the purpose for which selective disclosure was authorized, including a duty not to trade on such information. Before portfolio holdings may be selectively disclosed, requests approved by the PHC must also be authorized by either the Columbia Fund’s President, Chief Compliance Officer or General Counsel or their respective designees. On at least an annual basis, the PHC reviews the approved recipients of selective disclosure and may require a resubmission of the request, in order to re-authorize certain ongoing arrangements. These procedures are intended to be reasonably designed to protect the confidentiality of fund holdings information and to prohibit their release to individual investors, institutional investors, intermediaries that distribute the Columbia Funds’ shares, and other parties, until such holdings information is made public or unless such persons have been authorized to receive such holdings information on a selective basis, as set forth above.

The Columbia Funds currently have ongoing arrangements with certain approved recipients with respect to the disclosure of portfolio holdings information prior to such information being made public. Portfolio holdings information disclosed to such recipients is current as of the time of its disclosure, is disclosed to each recipient solely for purposes consistent with the services described below and has been authorized by the Columbia Funds’ President. These special arrangements are described in the table below.

Ongoing Portfolio Holdings Disclosure Arrangements

 

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
  

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS
ON USE OF INFORMATION

  

FREQUENCY
OF
DISCLOSURE

Standard & Poor’s    None    Use to maintain ratings for certain money market funds.    Weekly
InvestorTools, Inc.    None    Access granted solely for the purpose of testing back office conversion of trading systems.    Real time
ING Insurance Company    None    Access granted for specific Columbia Funds for ING’s creation of client/shareholder materials. ING may not distribute materials until the holdings information is made public.    Quarterly
Glass-Lewis & Co.    None    Access in connection with testing the firm’s proxy services.    Daily
CMS Bondedge    None    Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with application used by the Adviser’s Fixed Income Portfolio Management team as an analytical and trading tool.    Ad hoc

 

58


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
  

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS
ON USE OF INFORMATION

  

FREQUENCY
OF
DISCLOSURE

Linedata Services, Inc.    None    Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with the software for the LongView Trade Order Management System.    Ad hoc
JP Morgan    None    Access to provide the Adviser’s High Yield portfolio management team with peer group analysis reports for purposes of analyzing the portfolio.    Monthly
Malaspina Communications    None    Use to facilitate writing, publishing and mailing Columbia Fund shareholder reports and communications including shareholder letters and management’s discussion of Columbia Fund performance.    Quarterly
Evare LLP    None    Use for standardizing and reformatting data according to the Adviser’s specifications for use in the reconciliation process.    Daily
FactSet Research Systems, Inc.    None    Use for provision of quantitative analytics, charting and fundamental data to the Adviser and Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
RR Donnelley/WE Andrews    None    Access as printers for the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs, fact sheets and brochures.    Monthly
Merrill Corporation    None    Use to provide fulfillment of the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs and sales materials.    Monthly
Citigroup    None    Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with Yield Book, an analytic software program that the Adviser uses to perform ongoing risk analysis and management of certain fixed income Columbia Funds and fixed income separately managed accounts.    Daily

 

59


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
  

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS
ON USE OF INFORMATION

  

FREQUENCY
OF
DISCLOSURE

Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS)    None    Proxy voting administration and research on proxy matters utilized by MacKay Shields LLC, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
Cogent Consulting LLC    None    Utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds, to facilitate the evaluation of commission rates and to provide flexible commission reporting.    Daily
Moody’s    None    Ongoing portfolio surveillance for ratings it maintains on certain money market funds.    Monthly
Kynex    None    Use to provide portfolio attribution reports.    Daily
Bowne & Co.    None    Use for printing of the following materials: prospectuses, supplements and SAIs.    Monthly/ quarterly
Bloomberg    None    Use for portfolio analytics.    Daily
Barclays Point    None    Use for analytics including risk and attribution assessment.    Daily
Broadridge Financial Solutions, Inc.    None    Proxy voting and research utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Macgregor)    None    Order management system utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds that stores trading data and is used for trading and compliance purposes.    Ad hoc
Advent/AXP    None    Portfolio accounting system utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds, for both portfolio accounting and internal recordkeeping purposes.    Ad hoc
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Plexus Group)    None    Evaluation and assessment of trading activity, execution and practices by the Adviser.    Five days after quarter-end
BANA and State Street    None    Credit analysis performed by lenders.    Ad hoc
State Street    None    Use to provide custodian services.    Real time
Lipper    None    Use to create metrics for board and executive management reporting, product and marketing analysis, and fund performance.    Daily
Morningstar, Inc.    None    Use for independent research and ranking of Columbia Funds.    Daily

 

60


Table of Contents

 

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly, RiverSource Investments, LLC) (the Adviser) is the investment adviser and administrator of the Funds. The Adviser is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial. Ameriprise Financial is located at 1099 Ameriprise Financial Center, Minneapolis, MN 55474. The Adviser is located at 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110. Prior to May 1, 2010, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (the Previous Adviser), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Bank of America, was the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator.

The International Value Fund is a Feeder Fund and does not pay investment advisory fees because it invests all of its assets in Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. The Adviser earns its fee as the investment adviser to the Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. See the Management of the Fund – Primary Services Providers section in the International Value Fund’s prospectus.

Services Provided

Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, the Adviser has contracted to furnish each Fund with investment research and advice. For these services, each Fund pays a monthly fee to the Adviser based on the average of the daily closing value of the total net assets of a Fund for such month. Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, any liability of the Adviser to the Trust, a Fund and/or its shareholders is limited to situations involving the Adviser’s own willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence in the performance of its duties or reckless disregard of its obligations and duties.

The Investment Management Services Agreement may be terminated with respect to a Fund at any time on 60 days’ written notice by the Adviser or by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund. The Investment Management Services Agreement will automatically terminate upon any assignment thereof, will continue in effect for two years from May 1, 2010 and thereafter will continue from year to year with respect to a Fund only so long as such continuance is approved at least annually (i) by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund and (ii) by vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as such term is defined in the 1940 Act) of the Adviser or the Trust, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval.

The Adviser pays all compensation of the Trustees and officers of the Trust who are employees of the Adviser, except for the Chief Compliance Officer, a portion of whose salary is paid by the Columbia Funds. Except to the extent expressly assumed by the Adviser and except to the extent required by law to be paid or reimbursed by the Adviser, the Adviser does not have a duty to pay any Fund operating expense incurred in the organization and operation of a Fund, including, but not limited to, auditing, legal, custodial, investor servicing and shareholder reporting expenses. The Trust pays the cost of printing and mailing Fund prospectuses to shareholders.

The Adviser, at its own expense, provides office space, facilities and supplies, equipment and personnel for the performance of its functions under each Fund’s Investment Management Services Agreement.

Advisory Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

Each Fund pays the Adviser an annual fee for its investment advisory services, as set forth in the Investment Management Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Fees and Expenses of the Fund/Portfolio Annual Fund/Portfolio Operating Expenses in each Fund’s prospectuses. The fee is calculated as a percentage of the average daily net assets of each Fund and is paid monthly. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor and/or to selling and/or servicing agents for services they provide.

 

61


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser receives a monthly investment advisory fee based on each Fund’s average daily net assets at the following annual rates:

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
and up to
$1 billion
    In excess
of $1
billion
and up to
$1.5 billion
    In excess
of $1.5
billion
and up to
$3 billion
    In excess
of $3
billion
and up to
$6 billion
    In excess
of $6
billion
 

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Global Value Fund

     0.90     0.85     0.80     0.75     0.73     0.71

International Value Fund*

     0.85     0.80     0.75     0.70     0.68     0.66

Large Cap Core Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.50     0.45     0.43     0.41

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

     0.35     0.30     0.25     0.20     0.18     0.16

Large Cap Value Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.43     0.43     0.43     0.41

Marsico 21st Century Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.58     0.56

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.58     0.56

Marsico Growth Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.58     0.56

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.53     0.51

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Total Return Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

 

* Investment advisory fees are paid by Columbia International Value Master Portfolio, the Master Portfolio of the Feeder Fund.

 

Fund

   All assets  

Asset Allocation Fund II

     0.60

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     0.00

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     0.25

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     0.25

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     0.25

Large Cap Index Fund

     0.10

Marsico Global Fund

     0.80

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

     0.80

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     0.00

Mid Cap Index Fund

     0.10

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

     0.00

Overseas Value Fund

     0.82

Short Term Bond Fund

     0.30

Small Cap Index Fund

     0.10

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
and up to
$1 billion
    In excess
of $1
billion
and up to
$1.5 billion
    In excess
of $1.5
billion
 

Convertible Securities Fund

     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.50

High Income Fund

     0.55     0.52     0.49     0.46

Mid Cap Value Fund

     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.50

 

62


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
 

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     0.30     0.25

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
and up to
$1 billion
    In excess
of $1
billion
 

Small Cap Growth Fund II

     0.70     0.65     0.60

Small Cap Value Fund II

     0.70     0.65     0.60

For LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, the Adviser is entitled to receive an investment advisory fee of 0.50% on LifeGoal® Income Portfolio’s average daily net assets based on assets that are invested in individual securities, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio and Corporate Bond Portfolio. LifeGoal® Income Portfolio is not charged an advisory fee on its assets that are invested in other Columbia Funds (excluding Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio and Corporate Bond Portfolio. Actual management fees will be charged to the LifeGoal® Income Portfolio based on a weighted average of applicable underlying assets of the Portfolio).

Advisory Fees Paid by the Funds

The Previous Adviser received fees from the Funds for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show the advisory fees paid to and, as applicable, waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,864,932       $ 3,723,034       $ 6,072,972   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Global Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 600,279       $ 1,445,555       $ 3,094,056   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

   $ 187,426         —           —     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,787,603       $ 2,181,829       $ 2,717,957   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 366,741   

Amount Waived

   $ 151,553       $ 431,216         —     

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,231,458       $ 2,246,733       $ 2,721,298   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 1,647,710   

Amount Waived

   $ 1,389,496       $ 1,330,267         —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 11,014,155       $ 13,798,451       $ 19,857,743   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

   $ 66,850         —         $ 216,667   

 

63


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 25,152,257       $ 11,168,797       $ 42,309,565   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —         $ 415,508       $ 114,774   

Marsico Global Fund**

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 37,247       $ 30,317         N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Waived

   $ 178,993         —           N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 10,350,691       $ 19,536,182       $ 26,230,465   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,614,963       $ 1,674,088       $ 2,134,906   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 1,787,724   

Amount Waived

   $ 907,678       $ 1,688,944         —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 20,846,297       $ 22,018,205       $ 22,654,210   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 9,501,068       $ 12,759,354       $ 16,139,511   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 58,138       $ 59,187         N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 133,414       $ 208,317         N/A   

Amount Waived

     —           —        

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,163,978       $ 1,162,242       $ 1,544,845   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

   $ 43,874         —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 8,000,936       $ 7,949,823       $ 5,519,875   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Recovery of Fees Waived or Expenses Reimbursed by the Previous Adviser

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no advisory fees prior to that date.
*** Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no advisory fees prior to that date.

 

64


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2009*
    Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29,
2008*
    Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2007*
 

International Value Fund**

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 13,867,175       $ 18,922,007      $ 28,581,565      $ 32,446,266   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —          —          —     

Large Cap Core Fund

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,991,679       $ 6,940,605      $ 22,723 ***    $ 8,858,839   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —          —          —     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 18,946,739       $ 7,416,891      $ 78,891 ***    $ 27,024,538   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —         $ 224,668      $ 29,325        —     

Marsico Growth Fund

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 23,646,080       $ 7,022,977 1    $ 36,479,028 2    $ 30,737,961   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —        $ 88,981        —     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,294,866       $ 2,821,583      $ 9,170 ***    $ 3,660,996   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —          —          —     

Recovery of Fees Waived by the Previous Adviser

     —           —        $ 103,156        —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.
** Because this Feeder Fund’s advisory fees are paid at the Master Portfolio level, amounts shown are for its Master Portfolio, which may include one or more additional feeder funds.
*** Until February 28, 2008, the Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For the period April 1, 2007 to February 28, 2008, Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio paid $8,302,783 in advisory fees, Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Master Portfolio paid $27,944,659 in advisory fees and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II paid $3,791,375 in advisory fees.
1

Until November 10, 2008, Marsico Growth Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For the period March 1, 2008 to November 10, 2008, Columbia Marsico Growth Master Portfolio paid $25,572,128 in advisory fees, $309,527 of which was waived by the Adviser.

2

Amounts shown are for the Fund’s corresponding Master Portfolio, which may include one or more additional feeder funds.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 555,327       $ 624,721       $ 884,316   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 177,252         —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

65


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2008*
 

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 877,537       $ 895,804       $ 628,029   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 249,629       $ 299,298       $ 245,824   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 531,704       $ 508,291       $ 483,879   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 221,167       $ 212,433       $ 246,888   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

High Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,368,680       $ 1,251,540       $ 351,545 ** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,343,431       $ 1,479,159       $ 2,458,096   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 879,067       $ 1,008,735       $ 1,849,265   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 346,254       $ 362,391       $ 528,855   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 15,573       $ 16,419       $ 18,539   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 147,165       $ 88,426       $ 127,894   

Amount Waived

   $ 3,114       $ 3,284       $ 3,708   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 649,165       $ 637,768       $ 665,252   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 249,129       $ 239,429       $ 267,402   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 409,217       $ 483,770       $ 454,382   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

66


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2008*
 

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 807,714       $ 743,468       $ 716,191   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 259,947       $ 259,156       $ 293,196   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,778,812       $ 3,615,919       $ 2,820,376   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 531,044       $ 221,792       $ 188,025   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,376,376       $ 2,263,618       $ 1,244,272   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 223,599       $ 602,386       $ 470,889   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 810,122       $ 831,600       $ 735,156   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 247,880       $ 267,234       $ 273,304   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 4,695,452       $ 5,302,451       $ 6,392,539   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,332,156       $ 1,321,628       $ 1,314,492   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 298,704       $ 367,033       $ 386,045   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.
** Until February 28, 2008, the Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For the period April 1, 2007 to February 27, 2008, Columbia High Income Master Portfolio paid $6,040,994 in advisory fees, none of which was waived or reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for the Funds are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Alfred F. Alley III, CFA

  

Large Cap Index Fund

Mid Cap Index Fund

Small Cap Index Fund

Leonard A. Aplet, CFA

   Short Term Bond Fund

 

67


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Kent M. Bergene

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Wayne M. Collette, CFA

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Brian M. Condon, CFA

   Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Fred Copper, CFA

  

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund*

Overseas Value Fund

James D’Arcy, CFA

  

California Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

Georgia Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

Maryland Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Virginia Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

Lori J. Ensinger, CFA

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Jarl Ginsberg, CFA

   Small Cap Value Fund II

David I. Hoffman

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Yan Jin

   Convertible Securities Fund

David Joy

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

David L. King, CFA

   Convertible Securities Fund

Brian Lavin, CFA

   Total Return Bond Fund

Craig Leopold, CFA

   Large Cap Core Fund

Gregory Scott Liechty

   Short Term Bond Fund

 

68


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Lawrence W. Lin, CFA

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Colin Moore

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund*

George J. Myers, CFA

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Brian D. Neigut

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Carl W. Pappo, CFA

  

Corporate Bond Portfolio

Total Return Bond Fund

Kent M. Peterson, PhD

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Noah J. Petrucci, CFA

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Alexander D. Powers

   Total Return Bond Fund

Lee Reddin

   Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Peter Santoro, CFA

   Large Cap Core Fund

Marie M. Schofield, CFA

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Diane L. Sobin, CFA

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Christian K. Stadlinger, PhD, CFA

   Small Cap Value Fund II

Ronald B. Stahl, CFA

   Short Term Bond Fund

Michael W. Zazzarino

  

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Total Return Bond Fund

 

* Responsible for the portion of the Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund that is advised by the Adviser.

 

69


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about each Fund’s portfolio manager(s) as of the end of the Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date including the number and amount of assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the portfolio manager(s) managed.

 

         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28                
Convertible Securities Fund    Yan Jin   3 other accounts   $500,000   None   None   (1)
     David L. King, CFA1   18 other accounts   $38.5 million   None   None   (1)
Large Cap Core Fund    Craig Leopold, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

500 other accounts

  $75 million

$275 million

$1 billion

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
     Peter Santoro, CFA   2 RICs

2 PIVs

500 other accounts

  $150 million

$275 million

$1 billion

  None   $50,001-
$100,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund    Brian M. Condon, CFA   2 RICs

8 PIVs

38 other accounts

  $324 million

$837 million

$2.569 billion

  1 other account
($23 million)
  None   (1)
Large Cap Index Fund    Alfred F. Alley III, CFA   3 RICs

4 PIV

19 other accounts

  $3.382 billion

$224.9 million

$3.723 billion

  None   $1-
$10,000
a
  (1)
Large Cap Value Fund    Lori J. Ensinger, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,637 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a
  (1)
   David I. Hoffman   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
b
  (1)
   Noah J. Petrucci, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $50,001 -
$100,000
a

$1-
$10,000
b

  (1)
     Diane L. Sobin, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,648 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
Mid Cap Index
Fund
   Alfred F. Alley III, CFA   3 RICs

4 PIV

19 other accounts

  $4.104 billion

$224.9 million

$3.723 billion

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a
  (1)
Mid Cap Value Fund    Lori J. Ensinger, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,637 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $50,001-
$100,000
a
  (1)

 

70


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
   David I. Hoffman   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a
  (1)
   Noah J. Petrucci, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a
  (1)
     Diane L. Sobin, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,648 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund**    Fred Copper, CFA   9 RICs

4 PIV

24 other accounts

  $1.41 billion

$634.7 million

$86.9 million

  None   None   (1)
     Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  $2.12 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 million

  None   None   (1)
Overseas Value Fund    Fred Copper, CFA   9 RICs

4 PIV

24 other accounts

  $2.0 billion

$634.7 million

$86.9 million

  None   None   (1)
Small Cap Growth Fund II    Wayne M. Collette, CFA1   10 RICs

1 PIVs

114 other accounts

  $2.546 billion

$125.4 million

$216.4 million

  None   None   (1)
   Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   7 RICs

1 PIVs

108 other accounts

  $2.129 billion

$125.4 million

$138.8 million

  None   None   (1)
   George J. Myers, CFA1   7 RICs

1 PIVs

103 other accounts

  $2.129 billion

$125.4 million

$138.8 million

  None   None   (1)
     Brian D. Neigut1   7 RICs

1 PIV

105 other accounts

  $2.129 billion

$125.4 million

$138.6 million

  None   None   (1)
Small Cap Index
Fund
   Alfred F. Alley III, CFA   3 RICs

4 PIV

19 other accounts

  $4.656 billion

$224.9 million

$3.723 billion

  None   $1-
$10,000a
  (1)
Small Cap Value Fund II    Jarl Ginsberg, CFA   2 RICs

37 other accounts

  $0.2 billion

$0.4 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a
  (1)
     Christian K. Stadlinger, PhD, CFA   2 RICs

33 other accounts

  $0.2 billion

$0.4 billion

  None   $500,001-
$1,000,000
a

$50,001-
$100,000
b

  (1)

 

71


Table of Contents

 

         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31                
Asset Allocation Fund II    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $2 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.521 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $2 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $2 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Corporate Bond Portfolio    Carl W. Pappo, CFA   4 RICs

3 other accounts

  $5.626 billion

$850,000

  None   None   (1)
Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.519 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.039 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.519 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $1.519 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.708 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)

 

72


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.228 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.708 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $1.708 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.955 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.475 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.955 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $1.955 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $2.07 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.59 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $2.07 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)

 

73


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $2.07 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Masters International Equity Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.963 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Fred Copper, CFA   10 RICs

4 PIVs

24 other accounts

  $1.8 billion

$634.7 million

$92.4 million

  None   None   (1)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.483 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.963 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  $1.963 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio    Lee Reddin   2 other accounts   $120,000   None   None   (1)
     Michael W. Zazzarino   5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  $4.766 billion

$2.64 billion

$1.92 billion

  None   None   (1)
North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Short Term Bond Fund    Leonard A. Aplet, CFA   5 RICs

9 PIVs

80 other accounts

  $410 million

$3.34 billion

$3.65 billion

  None   Over
$1,000,000
a

$1-
$10,000
b

  (1)
   Gregory Scott Liechty   19 other accounts   $59 million   None   None   (1)
     Ronald B. Stahl   7 RICs

9 PIVs

62 other accounts

  $420 million

$3.34 billion

$3.64 billion

  None   None   (1)
Short Term Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a

$1-
$10,000
b

  (1)

 

74


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Total Return Bond Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA2   2 RICs

1 PIVs

4 other accounts

  $2.92 billion

$9.56 million

$766.77 million

  None   None   (2)
   Carl W. Pappo, CFA   4 RICs

3 other accounts

  $4.355 billion

$850,000

  None   None   (1)
   Alexander D. Powers   2 RICs

7 PIVs

17 other accounts

  $2.105 billion

$2.1 billion

$1.1 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Michael W. Zazzarino   5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  $3.516 billion

$2.64 billion

$1.92 billion

  None   None   (1)
Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
**

Reflects information for the portion of the Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund that is advised by the Adviser.

a

Excludes any notional investments.

b

Notional investments through a deferred compensation account.

1

Account information provided as of March 31, 2010.

2

Information provided as of April 30, 2010.

Structure of Compensation

(1) Compensation of Legacy Columbia Management Advisors, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of the Previous Adviser prior to May 1, 2010, is typically paid in the form of salary, bonus, stock options, restricted stock and notional investments through an incentive plan, the value of which is measured by reference to the performance of the Columbia Funds in which the account is invested. The bonus for these portfolio managers is variable and generally is based on (1) an evaluation of the portfolio manager’s investment performance and (2) the results of a peer and/or management review of the portfolio manager, which takes into account skills and attributes such as team participation, investment process, communication and professionalism. In evaluating investment performance, the Adviser generally considers the one, three and five year performance of mutual funds and other accounts managed by the portfolio manager relative to the benchmarks and peer groups noted below, emphasizing the portfolio manager’s three and five year performance. The Adviser also may consider a portfolio manager’s performance in managing client assets in sectors and industries assigned to the portfolio manager as part of his/her investment team responsibilities, when applicable. For portfolio managers who also have group management responsibilities, another factor in their evaluation is an assessment of the group’s overall investment performance. The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

 

75


Table of Contents

 

(2) Compensation of Legacy RiverSource Investments, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of RiverSource Investments, LLC (now known as Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC), is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, and (ii) an annual cash bonus, a portion of which may be subject to a mandatory deferral program, and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The Adviser’s portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Adviser employees. Depending upon their job level, Adviser portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Adviser employees at the same job level.

For Mr. Bergene and Mr. Joy, the annual cash bonus is based on management’s assessment of the employee’s performance relative to individual and business unit goals and objectives. The assessment may be based, in part, on achieving certain investment performance goals and retaining and attracting assets under management. For Mr. Joy, the assessment may be based, in part, on achieving certain investment performance goals and retaining and attracting assets under management, and for Mr. Bergene, on developing competitive products, managing existing products, and selecting and monitoring subadvisers for funds. In addition, subject to certain vesting requirements, the compensation of Mr. Joy includes an annual award based on the performance of Ameriprise Financial over rolling three-year periods. This program has been discontinued and the final award under this plan covered the three-year period that started in January 2007 and ended in December 2009.

For all other portfolio managers, the annual cash bonus is paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by the aggregate market competitive bonus targets for the teams of which the portfolio manager is a member and by the short-term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to applicable benchmarks or the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of the Adviser has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

Performance Benchmarks

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Alfred F. Alley III

   Large Cap Index Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper S&P 500 Index Objective Funds Classification
   Mid Cap Index Fund    S&P MidCap 400® Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Small Cap Index Fund    S&P Small Cap 600® Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification

Leonard A. Aplet

   Short Term Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 1-3 Year Government/Credit Index    Lipper Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

 

76


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Kent M. Bergene

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification

 

77


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Wayne M. Collette

   Small Cap Growth Fund II   

Russell 2000 Index

Russell 2000 Growth Index

   Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Brian M. Condon

   Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Classification

Fred Copper, CFA

   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    MSCI EAFE Index    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Overseas Value Fund    MSCI EAFE Value Index    Lipper International Large-Cap Value Funds Classification

James D’Arcy

   California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital California 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper California Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Short Term Municipal Bond Fund    BofA Merrill Lynch 1-3 Year U.S. Municipal Index    Lipper Short Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification

Lori J. Ensinger

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell MidCap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Jarl Ginsberg

   Small Cap Value Fund II    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Classificationa

 

78


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

David I. Hoffman

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell MidCap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Yan Jin

   Convertible Securities Fund    BofA Merrill Lynch
All Convertibles
All Qualities
   Lipper Convertible Securities Classification

David Joy

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification

David L. King

   Convertible Securities Fund    BofA Merrill Lynch
All Convertibles
All Qualities
   Lipper Convertible Securities Classification

Brian Lavin

   Total Return Bond Fund   

Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond

Index

   Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Craig Leopold

   Large Cap Core Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Classification

Gregory Scott Liechty

   Short Term Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 1-3 Year Government/Credit Index    Lipper Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Lawrence W. Lin

   Small Cap Growth Fund II    Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

79


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Colin Moore

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

George J. Myers

   Small Cap Growth Fund II    Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Brian D. Neigut

   Small Cap Growth Fund II    Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Carl W. Pappo

   Corporate Bond Portfolio    Barclays Capital
Credit Bond Index
   N/A
   Total Return Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Kent M. Peterson, PhD

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification

 

80


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Noah J. Petrucci

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell Mid Cap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Alexander D. Powers

   Total Return Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Lee Reddin

   Mortgage and Asset-Backed Portfolio    Barclays Capital U.S. Securitized Index    N/A

Peter Santoro

   Large Cap Core Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Classification

Marie M. Schofield, CFA

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification

 

81


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Diane L. Sobin

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell Mid Cap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Christian K. Stadlinger

   Small Cap Value Fund II    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Classification

Ronald B. Stahl

   Short Term Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 1-3 Year Government/Credit Index    Lipper Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Michael W. Zazzarino

   Mortgage and Asset-Backed Portfolio    Barclays Capital U.S. Securitized Index   

Lipper Intermediate Investment

 

Grade Debt Funds Classification

   Total Return Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment
Grade Debt Funds Classification

The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

Like other investment professionals with multiple clients, a Fund’s portfolio manager(s) may face certain potential conflicts of interest in connection with managing both the Fund and other accounts at the same time. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance policies and procedures that attempt to address certain of the potential conflicts that portfolio managers face in this regard. Certain of these conflicts of interest are summarized below.

The management of accounts with different advisory fee rates and/or fee structures, including accounts that pay advisory fees based on account performance (performance fee accounts), may raise potential conflicts of interest for a portfolio manager by creating an incentive to favor higher fee accounts.

Potential conflicts of interest also may arise when a portfolio manager has personal investments in other accounts that may create an incentive to favor those accounts. As a general matter and subject to the Adviser’s Code of Ethics and certain limited exceptions, the Adviser’s investment professionals do not have the opportunity to invest in client accounts, other than the Funds. A portfolio manager who is responsible for managing multiple funds and/or accounts may devote unequal time and attention to the management of those funds and/or accounts. The effects of this potential conflict may be more pronounced where funds and/or accounts managed by a particular portfolio manager have different investment strategies.

 

82


Table of Contents

 

A portfolio manager may be able to select or influence the selection of the broker/dealers that are used to execute securities transactions for the Funds. A portfolio manager’s decision as to the selection of broker/dealers could produce disproportionate costs and benefits among the Funds and the other accounts the portfolio manager manages.

A potential conflict of interest may arise when a portfolio manager buys or sells the same securities for a Fund and other accounts. On occasions when a portfolio manager considers the purchase or sale of a security to be in the best interests of a Fund as well as other accounts, the Adviser’s trading desk may, to the extent consistent with applicable laws and regulations, aggregate the securities to be sold or bought in order to obtain the best execution and lower brokerage commissions, if any. Aggregation of trades may create the potential for unfairness to a Fund or another account if a portfolio manager favors one account over another in allocating the securities bought or sold.

“Cross trades,” in which a portfolio manager sells a particular security held by a Fund to another account (potentially saving transaction costs for both accounts), could involve a potential conflict of interest if, for example, a portfolio manager is permitted to sell a security from one account to another account at a higher price than an independent third party would pay. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance procedures that provide that any transactions between the Fund and another account managed by the Adviser are to be made at a current market price, consistent with applicable laws and regulations.

Another potential conflict of interest may arise based on the different investment objectives and strategies of a Fund and other accounts managed by its portfolio manager(s). Depending on another account’s objectives and other factors, a portfolio manager may give advice to and make decisions for a Fund that may differ from advice given, or the timing or nature of decisions made, with respect to another account. A portfolio manager’s investment decisions are the product of many factors in addition to basic suitability for the particular account involved. Thus, a portfolio manager may buy or sell a particular security for certain accounts, and not for a Fund, even though it could have been bought or sold for the Fund at the same time. A portfolio manager also may buy a particular security for one or more accounts when one or more other accounts are selling the security (including short sales). There may be circumstances when a portfolio manager’s purchases or sales of portfolio securities for one or more accounts may have an adverse effect on other accounts, including the Funds.

A Fund’s portfolio manager(s) also may have other potential conflicts of interest in managing the Fund, and the description above is not a complete description of every conflict that could exist in managing the Fund and other accounts. Many of the potential conflicts of interest to which the Adviser’s portfolio managers are subject are essentially the same or similar to the potential conflicts of interest related to the investment management activities of the Adviser and its affiliates. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

Manager of Managers Exemption

The SEC has issued an order that permits the Adviser, subject to the approval of the Board, to appoint an unaffiliated subadviser or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for a Fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits a Fund to add or to change unaffiliated subadvisers or to change the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change. The Adviser and its affiliates may have other relationships, including significant financial relationships, with current or potential subadvisers or their affiliates, which may create certain conflicts of interest. When making recommendations to the Board to appoint or to change a subadviser, or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement, the Adviser discloses to the Board the nature of any material relationships it has with a subadviser or its affiliates.

 

83


Table of Contents

 

For Global Value Fund and Marsico Growth Fund, if the Funds were to seek to rely on the order, holders of a majority of the fund’s outstanding voting securities would need to approve operating the fund in this manner. There is no assurance shareholder approval, if sought, will be received, and no changes will be made without shareholder approval until that time.

The Subadvisers and Investment Subadvisory Services

Brandes

Brandes is the investment subadviser to Global Value Fund and Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. The International Value Fund is a Feeder Fund and does not have its own subadviser(s) because it invests all of its assets in Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. With respect to the International Value Fund, Brandes earns its fee as the investment subadviser to the Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. See the Management of the Fund – Primary Services Providers section in the International Value Fund’s prospectus.

Brandes is 100% beneficially owned by senior professionals of the firm. The principal offices of Brandes are located at 11988 El Camino Real, Suite 500, San Diego, California 92130. As of March 31, 2010, Brandes had approximately $51.6 billion in assets under management.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, Brandes selects and manages the respective investments of each Fund for which it serves as investment subadviser. Brandes performs its duties subject at all times to the control of the Board and in conformity with the stated policies of each Fund.

Its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement generally provides that in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of Brandes’ obligations or duties thereunder, or any of its respective officers, directors, employees or agents, Brandes shall not be subject to liability to the Trust or to any shareholder of the Trust for any act or omission in the course of rendering services thereunder or for any losses that may be sustained in the purchase, holding or sale of any security.

The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement became effective with respect to a Fund after approval by the Board, and after an initial two year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Trust’s Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to a Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Adviser on 60 days’ written notice.

The Adviser, from the investment advisory fees it receives, pays Brandes for the services it provides to a Fund based on the percentage of the average daily net assets of that Fund, as set forth in the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor or to selling or servicing agents for services they provide.

 

84


Table of Contents

 

Subadvisory Rates Paid to Brandes

The Adviser pays Brandes, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Global Value Fund and Columbia International Value Master Portfolio, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the average daily net assets:

 

Fund/Master Portfolio

  

Rate of Compensation

Global Value Fund

  

•   0.50% on aggregate assets of Global Value Fund on the first $1 billion

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of Global Value Fund above $1 billion

Columbia International Value Master Portfolio

  

•   0.50% of average daily net assets of International Value Master Portfolio

Subadvisory Fees Paid to Brandes

Brandes received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for its services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the subadvisory fees paid to Brandes, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Global Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 324,922       $ 799,901       $ 1,715,858   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29, 2008
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31, 2007
 

International Value Fund*

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 8,841,168       $ 12,462,818       $ 19,593,220       $ 22,308,152   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* Because this Feeder Fund’s advisory fees are paid at the Master Portfolio level, amounts shown are for its Master Portfolio.

Brandes Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the Brandes portfolio manager(s) responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds identified below. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Brandes portfolio manager(s) responsible for the Fund(s) are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Jim Brown, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Glenn R. Carlson, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Brent Fredberg

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

 

85


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Jeffrey Germain, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Amelia M. Morris, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Brent V. Woods, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Brandes Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about the number and assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the Brandes portfolio manager(s) managed, as of the end of each Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date.

 

        Other Accounts Managed by the Brandes Portfolio Managers
(excluding the Fund)
   
Fund   Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned

For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28

Global Value Fund   Jim Brown, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
 

Glenn R. Carlson, CFA1

  8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Brent Fredberg1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Jeffrey Germain, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Amelia M. Morris, CFA1   8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
   

Brent V. Woods, CFA1

  8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None

International Value Fund

  Jim Brown, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None

 

86


Table of Contents
        Other Accounts Managed by the Brandes Portfolio Managers
(excluding the Fund)
   
Fund   Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned
  Glenn R. Carlson, CFA1   8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Brent Fredberg1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Jeffrey Germain, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Amelia M. Morris, CFA1   8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
   

Brent V. Woods, CFA1

  8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
1

Account information provided as of March 31, 2010.

Brandes Portfolio Manager(s) Compensation

Brandes’ compensation structure for portfolio managers/analysts is four-fold: competitive base salaries, participation in an annual bonus plan, participation in profit sharing plan and eligibility for participation in the firm’s equity through partnership or phantom equity. Compensation is fixed. Participation in the annual bonus plan is linked to a number of qualitative and quantitative evaluation criteria. The criteria include research productivity, performance of portfolio management professionals, and the attainment of client service goals. Compensation is not based on the performance of the Fund or other accounts.

Brandes Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

For a small number of accounts, Brandes may be compensated based on the profitability of the account, such as by a performance-based management fee. These incentive compensation structures may create a conflict of interest for Brandes with regard to other accounts where the Adviser is paid based on a percentage of assets in that the portfolio manager may have an incentive to allocate securities preferentially to the accounts where Brandes might share in investment gains. In order to address these potential conflicts, Brandes’ investment decision-making and trade allocation policies and procedures are designed to ensure that none of Brandes’ clients are disadvantaged in Brandes’ management of accounts. Additionally, Brandes’ internal controls are tested on a routine schedule as part of the firm’s Compliance Monitoring Program.

It is possible that at times identical securities will be held by more than one fund and/or account. If the Large Cap Investment Committee identifies a limited investment opportunity that may be suitable for more than

 

87


Table of Contents

one Fund or other account, a Fund may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of filled purchase or sale orders across all eligible Funds and other accounts. To deal with these situations, Brandes has adopted procedures for allocating portfolio transactions across multiple accounts. For client accounts, including the Fund, that are able to participate in aggregated transactions, Brandes utilizes a rotational trading system to execute client transactions in order to provide, over the long-run, fair treatment for each client account.

Members of the Large Cap Investment Committee may invest in a fund or other account that they are involved in the management of and a conflict may arise where they may therefore have an incentive to treat the fund that they invest in preferentially as compared to other accounts. In order to address this potential conflict, Brandes’ investment decision-making and trade allocation policies and procedures are designed to ensure that none of Brandes’ clients are disadvantaged in Brandes’ management of accounts.

Causeway

Causeway served as co-investment subadviser to approximately half of the assets of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund until July 8, 2009. At that time, the Previous Adviser assumed primary investment management responsibility for that portion of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund previously sub-advised by Causeway.

Subadvisory Rates Paid to Causeway

Until July 8, 2009, at which time the Adviser assumed primary investment management responsibility for that portion of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund previously sub-advised by Causeway, the Previous Adviser paid Causeway, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rate listed below as a percentage of the average daily net assets of the Fund:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

  

•   0.43% of aggregate average daily net assets of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Subadvisory Fees Paid to Causeway

Causeway received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for its services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the subadvisory fees paid to Causeway, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal years.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2008
 

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,379,059       $ 4,183,414       $ 5,502,776   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

MacKay Shields

MacKay Shields is the investment subadviser to High Income Fund. MacKay Shields’ principal office is located at 9 West 57th Street, New York, NY 10019.

 

88


Table of Contents

 

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, MacKay Shields selects and manages the respective investments of High Income Fund for which it serves as investment subadviser. MacKay Shields performs its duties subject at all times to the control of the Board and in conformity with the stated policies of the Fund. Its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement generally provides that in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of MacKay Shields’ obligations or duties thereunder, or any of its respective officers, directors, employees or agents, MacKay Shields shall not be subject to liability to the Trust or to any shareholder of the Trust for any act or omission in the course of rendering services thereunder or for any losses that may be sustained in the purchase, holding or sale of any security.

The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement became effective with respect to a Fund after approval by the Board, and after an initial two year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Trust’s Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to a Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Adviser on 60 days’ written notice.

The Adviser, from the investment advisory fees it receives, pays MacKay Shields for the services it provides to a Fund based on the percentage of the average daily net assets of that Fund, as set forth in the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor or to selling or servicing agents for services they provide.

Subadvisory Rates Paid to MacKay Shields

The Adviser pays MacKay Shields full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Columbia High Income Fund, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the average daily net assets of the Fund:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

High Income Fund

  

•   0.40% of the average daily net assets of High Income Fund up to and including $100 million

•   0.375% of average daily net assets of High Income Fund in excess of $100 million and up to and including $200 million

•   0.35% of average daily net assets of High Income Fund in excess of $200 million

Subadvisory Fees Paid to MacKay Shields

MacKay Shields received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for its services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the subadvisory fees paid to MacKay Shields, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal periods.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

High Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,737,848       $ 2,508,574       $ 3,219,688   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

*

Until February 28, 2008, the Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For

 

89


Table of Contents
 

the period April 1, 2007 to February 28, 2008, Columbia High Income Master Portfolio paid $2,985,314 in advisory fees, and from February 28, 2008 through March 31, 2008, the Fund paid $234,374 in subadvisory fees.

MacKay Shields Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the MacKay Shields portfolio manager responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Fund identified below. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of the Fund’s prospectus, the MacKay Shields portfolio manager responsible for the Fund is:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

J. Matthew Philo, CFA

   High Income Fund

MacKay Shields Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about the number and assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the MacKay Shields portfolio manager(s) managed, as of the end of the Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date.

 

         

Other Accounts Managed by the MacKay Shields
Portfolio Managers (excluding the Fund)

      
Fund    Portfolio Manager    Number and Type
of Account*
   Approximate
Total Net Assets
   Performance
Based Accounts
   Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially Owned
 

For the Fund with fiscal year ending March 31

     

High Income Fund

   J. Matthew Philo,
CFA
  

4 RICs

2 PIVs

46 other accounts

  

$7.907 billion

$450 million

$10.6 billion

   2 PIVs ($12.7 million)      None   

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.

MacKay Shields Portfolio Manager(s) Compensation

MacKay Shields establishes salaries at competitive levels, verified through industry surveys, to attract and maintain the best professional talent. In addition, an incentive bonus equal to a significant percentage of the firm’s pre-tax profits is paid annually to the firm’s employees based upon an individual’s performance and the profitability of the firm. The bonus generally represents a sizable amount relative to the base salary, and when considered with the base salary, results in a highly attractive level of total cash compensation for the firm’s professional employees. Every MacKay Shields employee participates in the bonus pool. This approach instills a strong sense of commitment on the part of each employee towards the overall success of the firm. There is no difference between the method used in determining portfolio manager’s compensation with respect to the High Income Fund and other accounts.

MacKay Shields has performance-based fee arrangements with “eligible clients”, as that term is defined under Rule 205-3 of the 1940 Act, who have requested such arrangements. Performance-based fees may be calculated as a percentage of returns, or as a percentage of the increase in net asset value, and may be tied to a client-directed benchmark or loss carry forward. A portion of these performance-based fees forms a part of the bonus pool for all MacKay Shields employees. Of course, there are periods in which MacKay Shields does not earn any performance fee. Such arrangements may appear to create an incentive to make riskier, more speculative investments than would be the case under a solely asset-based fee arrangement.

 

90


Table of Contents

 

MacKay Shields offers a Phantom Stock Plan, which enhances the firm’s ability to attract, retain, motivate, and reward key executives. Awards can be made annually and vesting takes place over a period of several subsequent years. Participation in the current plan by senior professionals is contingent upon the execution of an Executive Employment Agreement.

MacKay Shields Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

MacKay Shields’ High Yield group provides portfolio services for other MacKay Shields accounts, which include: mutual funds; institutional managed accounts; collective trusts and private commingled funds. As previously reported, MacKay Shields’ High Yield group has a domestic hedge fund and an offshore hedge fund, both of which are closed to new investors and whose assets were substantially liquidated during 2009. Except for distinctions based on investment objectives, investment guidelines and cash flow, all accounts are treated the same, regardless of fee structure.

MacKay Shields has performance-based fee arrangements with “eligible clients” (as that term is defined under Rule 205-3 of the 1940 Act) who have requested such arrangements. Performance-based fees may be calculated as a percentage of returns, or as a percentage of the increase in net asset value, and may be tied to a client-directed benchmark or loss carry forward. A portion of these performance-based fees forms a part of the bonus pool for all MacKay Shields employees. Of course, there are periods in which MacKay Shields does not earn any performance fee. Such arrangements may appear to create an incentive to make riskier, more speculative investments than would be the case under a solely asset-based fee arrangement. As previously reported, the two hedge funds with performance fees managed by the same product area that manages the High Income Fund are in the process of being liquidated.

To address potential conflicts of interest, MacKay Shields has adopted various policies and procedures to provide for equitable treatment of trading activity and to ensure that investment opportunities are allocated in a fair and appropriate manner. In addition, MacKay Shields has adopted a Code of Ethics and other policies and procedures that recognize a manager’s obligation to treat all of its clients, including the High Income Fund, fairly and equitably. These policies, procedures, and the Code of Ethics are designed to restrict a portfolio manager from favoring one client over another.

It is the policy of MacKay Shields not to favor any one client over another. Consistent with this policy,

MacKay Shields has the following procedures, among others: (1) trade allocation procedures that provide for the

pro rata allocation of investment opportunities among clients in a particular strategy, with certain exceptions; (2) a general prohibition against same day opposite direction transactions; and (3) short sale trade procedures requiring pre-approval of short sales and restricting certain short sales.

The Trade Allocation Policy provides that: (i) no client will be favored over any other client; (ii) trades should be pre-allocated, subject to certain exceptions, and allocations should be in writing; and (iii) MacKay Shields’ Legal/Compliance Department conducts periodic reviews of client account performance as a function of allocation to assure that no account or group of accounts is being preferred systematically in the allocation process. The Trade Allocation Policy contains a procedure for limited offerings, which provides that in a limited offering, the allocations may be pro-rata based on size of the order or account size and within a Strategy pro-rata based on account size. Under this policy, when determining which accounts will participate in a trade, the portfolio managers will consider various objective criteria which may include but are not limited to: client cash limitations, actual and anticipated account inflows and outflows, duration and/or average maturity, account size, deal size, trade lots, existing exposure to an issuer or industry type and specific investment objectives and other practical limitations. In general, if the aggregated order is filled in its entirety, it will be allocated among clients in accordance with the target allocation; if the order is partially filled, it will be allocated pro rata based on the allocation methodology recorded in the trade order management system.

 

91


Table of Contents

 

The Cross Trading Policy provides that all cross trades must be pre-cleared by the MacKay Shields Legal/ Compliance Department and require, among other things, that the transaction (a) be a purchase or sale for no consideration other than cash payments against prompt delivery of the security, (b) is effected at the independent market price of the security determined in accordance with applicable methodology; and (c) be effected with no brokerage transaction.

The Valuation Procedures provide, among other requirements, that any fair valuation of a security recommended by a portfolio manager be approved by portfolio managers from two other distinct portfolio management areas. In addition, on a monthly basis a Fair Valuation Committee meeting convenes to review all securities that are being fair valued.

The Proxy-Voting Policies and Procedures are designed to ensure that where clients have delegated proxy voting authority to MacKay Shields, all proxies are voted in the best interest of such clients without regard to the interests of MacKay Shields or related parties. When a client retains MacKay Shields, the firm generally determines through its investment management agreement whether it is authorized to vote proxies on behalf of that client. Currently, MacKay Shields uses Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS), a business unit of RiskMetrics Group, as its third-party proxy voting service provider. If the client appoints MacKay Shields as its proxy-voting agent, the client will also be asked to specify whether its proxies should be voted in accordance with Custom Guidelines provided by the client or in accordance with MacKay Shields’ Standard Guidelines for non-union clients or union clients, as the case may be. These Standard Guidelines follow ISS proxy voting recommendations. MacKay Shields informs the client’s custodian to send all proxies to ISS, and informs ISS that the client has appointed MacKay Shields as its agent and instructs ISS as to which guidelines to follow.

Marsico

Marsico is located at 1200 17th Street, Suite 1600, Denver, CO 80202. Marsico was organized in September 1997 as a registered investment adviser, became a wholly owned indirect subsidiary of Bank of America in January 2001 and was an affiliate of the Previous Adviser until December 2007. Marsico is an independently owned investment management firm. Marsico provides investment management services to other mutual funds and private accounts and, as of March 31, 2010, Marsico had approximately $55 billion in assets under management.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, Marsico selects and manages the respective investments of the Funds for which it serves as investment subadviser. Marsico performs its duties subject at all times to the control of the Board and in conformity with the stated policies of each Fund.

Its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement generally provides that in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of Marsico’s obligations or duties thereunder, or any of its respective officers, directors, employees or agents, Marsico shall not be subject to liability to the Trust or to any shareholder of the Trust for any act or omission in the course of rendering services thereunder or for any losses that may be sustained in the purchase, holding or sale of any security.

The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement became effective with respect to a Fund after approval by the Board, and after an initial two year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Trust’s Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to a Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Adviser on 60 days’ written notice.

 

92


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser, from the investment advisory fees it receives, pays Marsico for the services it provides to a Fund based on the percentage of the average daily net assets of that Fund, as set forth in the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor or to selling or servicing agents for services they provide.

Subadvisory Rates Paid to Marsico

Effective May 1, 2010, the Adviser pays Marsico, and for the period May 1, 2010 through January 1, 2008, the Previous Adviser paid Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico 21st Century Fund, Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Marsico Growth Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the aggregate average daily net assets of Columbia U.S. equity funds or portions thereof subadvised by Marsico (“U.S. Funds”)*:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

U.S. Funds

  

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of the U.S. Funds up to $18 billion

•   0.40% on aggregate assets of the U.S. Funds between $18 billion and $21 billion

•   0.35% on aggregate assets of the U.S. Funds above $21 billion

 

*

For purposes of this fee calculation, the assets subadvised by Marsico in the following Columbia Funds will be aggregated: (i) Marsico 21st Century Fund; (ii) Marsico Focused Equities Fund; (iii) Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund, Variable Series; (iv) Columbia Marsico Growth Fund, Variable Series; (v) Columbia Marsico Focused Equities, Variable Series; (vi) Marsico Growth Fund; and (vii) any future Columbia U.S. equity fund subadvised by Marsico, as the Adviser and Marsico mutually agree in writing.

Effective May 1, 2010, the Adviser pays Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico Global Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund and Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the aggregate average daily net assets of Columbia international equity funds or portions thereof subadvised by Marsico (“International Funds”)*:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

International Funds

  

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of the International Funds up to $6 billion

•   0.40% on aggregate assets of the International Funds between $6 billion and $10 billion

•   0.35% on aggregate assets of the International Funds above $10 billion

 

* For purposes of this fee calculation, the assets subadvised by Marsico in the following Columbia Funds will be aggregated: (i) Marsico Global Fund; (ii) Marsico International Opportunities Fund; (iii) Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund; (iv) Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Variable Series; and (v) any future Columbia international equity fund subadvised by Marsico, as the Adviser and Marsico mutually agree in writing.

 

93


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser pays Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico Global Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the aggregate average daily net assets of the Marsico Global Fund:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

Marsico Global Fund

  

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of the Marsico Global Fund up to $1.5 billion

•   0.40% on aggregate assets of the Marsico Global Fund between $1.5 billion and $3 billion

•   0.35% on aggregate assets of the Marsico Global Fund above $3 billion

For the period May 1, 2010 through January 1, 2008, the Previous Adviser paid Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico Global Fund and Marsico International Opportunities Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates of 0.80% of the aggregate average daily net assets of U.S. Funds.

Immediately prior to January 1, 2008, the Previous Adviser paid Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Marsico 21st Century Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Marsico Growth Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund and Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rate of 0.45% of the average net assets of the respective Fund.

Subadvisory Fees Paid to Marsico

Marsico received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for Marsico’s services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the advisory fees paid to Marsico, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal periods.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2010
    Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2009
    Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Marsico 21st Century Fund

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 17,890,538      $ 30,553,834      $ 8,068,502   

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —          —          —     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 13,085,046      $ 17,405,934      $ 4,579,577 ** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —          —          —     

Marsico Global Fund***

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 20,688      $ 17,043        N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          N/A   

Amount Waived

     —          —          N/A   

Marsico Growth Fund

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 16,721,820      $ 23,371,676 **    $ 6,299,921   

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —          —          —     

 

94


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2010
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2009
     Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,728,038       $ 10,955,978       $ 2,927,361   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,532,116       $ 4,836,093       $ 1,316,794   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* Marsico was an affiliated investment subadviser of the Previous Adviser until December 14, 2007. Therefore, the subadvisory fees paid are for the period December 14, 2007 through February 29, 2008.
** Includes amount paid for services provided to former Master Portfolio.
*** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no subadvisory fees prior to that date.

Marsico Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the Marsico portfolio manager(s) responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds identified below. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Marsico portfolio manager(s) responsible for the Fund(s) are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

James G. Gendelman

   Marsico Global Fund
   Marsico International Opportunities Fund
   Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Corydon J. Gilchrist, CFA

   Marsico 21st Century Fund
   Marsico Global Fund

Thomas F. Marsico

   Marsico Focused Equities Fund
   Marsico Global Fund
   Marsico Growth Fund

A. Douglas Rao

   Marsico Focused Equities Fund
   Marsico Growth Fund

Marsico Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about the number and assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the Marsico portfolio manager(s) managed, as of the end of each Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date.

 

         Other Accounts Managed by the Marsico Portfolio
Managers  (excluding the Fund)
        
Fund    Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
   Approximate
Total Net
Assets
   Performance
Based Accounts
     Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28

  

Marsico 21st Century Fund    Corydon
J.
Gilchrist,
CFA
a
  5 RICs

9 PIVs

10 other accounts

   $4.927 billion

$1.577 billion

$1.6 billion

     None         None   

 

95


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed by the Marsico Portfolio
Managers  (excluding the Fund)
        
Fund    Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
   Approximate
Total Net
Assets
   Performance
Based Accounts
     Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned
 
Marsico Focused Equities Fund    Thomas F.
Marsico
b
  30 RICs

15 PIVs

136
other
accounts

   $16.402 billion

$2.286 billion

$13.613 billion

     None         None   
     A. Douglas
Rao
c
  10 RICs

2 other
accounts

   $10.335 billion

$4.757 billion

     None         None   
Marsico Global Fund    James G.
Gendelman
  20 RICs

8 PIVs

22 other
accounts

   $8.801 billion

$1.238 billion

$2.201 billion

     None         None   
   Corydon J.
Gilchrist,
CFA
a
  5 RICs

9 PIVs

10 other
accounts

   $4.927 billion

$1.577 billion

$1.6 billion

     None         None   
     Thomas F.
Marsico
b
  30 RICs

15 PIVs

136
other
accounts

   $19.352 billion

$2.286 billion

$13.613 billion

     None         None   
Marsico Growth Fund    Thomas F.
Marsico
b
  30 RICs

15 PIVs

136
other
accounts

   $15.647 billion

$2.286 billion

$13.613 billion

     None         None   
     A. Douglas
Rao
c
  10 RICs

2 other
accounts

   $9.580 billion

$4.757 billion

     None         None   
Marsico International Opportunities Fund    James G.
Gendelman
  20 RICs

8 PIVs

22 other
accounts

   $7.607 billion

$1.238 billion

$2.201 billion

     None         None   
Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    James G.
Gendelman
  20 RICs

8 PIVs

22 other
accounts

   $8.062 billion

$1.238 billion

$2.201 billion

     None         None   

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
a

One of the “Other Accounts” is a wrap fee platform, which includes 2,357 of underlying clients with total assets of approximately $458 million and one of the “Other Accounts” represents a model portfolio with total assets of approximately $117 million.

b

One of the “Other Accounts” is a wrap fee platform, which includes 9,270 underlying clients with total assets of approximately $2,945 and two of the “Other Accounts” represent model portfolio with total assets of approximately $1.813 billion.

 

96


Table of Contents
c

The “Other Accounts” are a wrap fee platform, which includes approximately 9,270 underlying clients with total assets of approximately $2.945 billion, and a model portfolio with total assets of approximately $1.812 billion.

Marsico Portfolio Manager(s) Compensation

The compensation package for portfolio managers of Marsico is structured as a combination of base salary (may be reevaluated at least annually), and periodic cash bonuses. Bonuses are typically based on a number of factors including Marsico’s overall profitability for the period. Portfolio manager compensation takes into account, among other factors, the overall performance of all accounts for which the portfolio manager provides investment advisory services. In receiving compensation such as bonuses, portfolio managers do not receive special consideration based on the performance of particular accounts, and do not receive compensation from accounts charging performance-based fees. Exceptional individual efforts are rewarded through salary readjustments and greater participation in the bonus pool. No other special employee incentive arrangements are currently in place or being planned. In addition to salary and bonus, portfolio managers may participate in other Marsico benefits to the same extent and on the same basis as other Marsico employees. Portfolio manager compensation comes solely from Marsico. In addition, Marsico’s portfolio managers typically are offered equity interests in Marsico Management Equity, LLC, which indirectly owns Marsico, and may receive distributions on those equity interests.

As a general matter, Marsico does not tie portfolio manager compensation to specific levels of performance relative to fixed benchmarks. Although performance may be a relevant consideration, comparisons with fixed benchmarks may not always be useful. Relevant benchmarks vary depending on specific investment styles and client guidelines or restrictions, and comparisons to benchmark performance may at times reveal more about market sentiment than about a portfolio manager’s abilities. To encourage a long-term horizon for managing portfolios, Marsico evaluates a portfolio manager’s performance over periods longer than the immediate compensation period, and may consider a variety of measures such as the performance of unaffiliated portfolios with similar strategies and other measurements. Other factors that may also be significant in determining portfolio manager compensation include, without limitation, the effectiveness of the manager’s leadership within Marsico’s investment team, contributions to Marsico’s overall performance, discrete securities analysis, idea generation, ability to support and train other analysts, and other considerations.

Marsico Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

As a general matter, Marsico faces the same need to balance the interests of different clients that any investment adviser with multiple clients might experience. Portfolio managers make investment decisions for each portfolio based on the investment objectives, policies, practices and other relevant investment considerations that the managers believe are applicable to that portfolio. Consequently, portfolio managers may or may not purchase (or sell) securities for one portfolio and not another portfolio, or may take similar actions for different portfolios at different times. As a result, the mix of securities purchased in one portfolio may perform better than the mix of securities purchased for another portfolio. Similarly, the sale of securities from one portfolio may cause that portfolio to perform better than others if the value of those securities subsequently decline. The management of multiple accounts may result in a portfolio manager devoting unequal time and attention to the management of each account. Although Marsico does not track the time a portfolio manager spends on a single portfolio, it does assess whether a portfolio manager has adequate time and resources to effectively manage all of the accounts for which he is responsible. Marsico seeks to manage competing interests for the time and attention of portfolio managers.

The need to balance the interests of multiple clients may also arise when allocating and/or aggregating trades. Marsico often aggregates into a single trade order several individual contemporaneous client trade orders in a single security. Under Marsico’s Portfolio Management and Trade Management Policy and Procedures, when trades are aggregated on behalf of more than one account, Marsico seeks to allocate such trades to

 

97


Table of Contents

participating client accounts in a fair and equitable manner. With respect to IPOs and other syndicated or limited offerings, it is Marsico’s policy to seek to ensure that over the long term, accounts with the same or similar investment objectives or strategies will receive an equitable opportunity to participate meaningfully and will not be unfairly disadvantaged. To deal with these situations, Marsico has adopted policies and procedures for allocating transactions across multiple accounts. Marsico’s policies also seek to ensure that portfolio managers do not systematically allocate other types of trades in a manner that would be more beneficial to one account than another. Marsico’s compliance department monitors transactions made on behalf of multiple clients to seek to ensure adherence to its policies.

Marsico has adopted and implemented policies and procedures that seek to minimize potential conflicts of interest that may arise as a result of a portfolio manager advising multiple accounts. In addition, Marsico monitors a variety of areas, including compliance with primary Fund guidelines, the allocation of securities, and compliance with its Code of Ethics.

The Administrator

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (which is also the Adviser) serves as Administrator of the Funds.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator has agreed to provide all of the services and facilities necessary for, or appropriate to, the business and effective operation of each Fund that are not (a) provided by employees or other agents engaged by each Fund or (b) required to be provided by any person pursuant to any other agreement or arrangement with each Fund.

Administration Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

The Administrator receives fees as compensation for its services, which are computed daily and paid monthly, as set forth in the Administrative Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Primary Service Providers – The Administrator in each Fund’s prospectuses.

The Previous Administrator received fees from the Funds for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show administration fees paid to and, as applicable waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 645,345       $ 867,215       $ 1,501,974   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Global Value Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 65,422       $ 211,052       $ 483,369   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 760,800       $ 970,695       $ 1,247,255   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

98


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,231,508       $ 2,238,144       $ 2,721,298   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 3,641,178       $ 4,741,946       $ 7,040,233   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 200,002       $ 200,001   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 8,603,983       $ 15,005,283       $ 15,184,769   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Marsico Global Fund***

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,706,440       $ 5,232,450       $ 7,047,989   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,474,963       $ 1,534,088       $ 1,983,318   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 6,437,740       $ 6,836,190       $ 7,040,843   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,340,535       $ 3,345,352       $ 4,370,355   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Waived

     —           —           N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,163,978       $ 1,162,133       $ 1,544,239   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,916,545       $ 1,901,446       $ 1,229,303   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

99


Table of Contents
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no administration fees prior to that date.
***

Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no administration fees prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
    Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

International Value Fund**

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,523,528       $ 3,627,490       $ 5,790,419      $ 6,574,153   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Large Cap Core Fund

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,646,222       $ 1,967,356       $ 1,820,111 ***    $ 1,907,360 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Marsico Focused Equities

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 6,259,486       $ 8,469,821       $ 5,370,916 ***    $ 5,095,728 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Marsico Growth Fund

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 8,032,650       $ 7,436,572       $ 7,074,752 ***    $ 5,791,064 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 296,532       $ 372,770       $ 331,182 ***    $ 416,914 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.
** The Administration fees are paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder Fund –levels; amounts shown above include only the portion paid at the Feeder Fund-level.
*** Prior to the Fund’s conversion from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund, the Administration fees were paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder-Fund levels; amounts shown include only the portion paid at the Feeder-Fund level.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 56,172       $ 68,070       $ 103,492   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 258,160       $ 264,344       $ 163,661   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

100


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 141,447       $ 133,545       $ 115,028   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

High Income Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,610,648       $ 1,462,420       $ 1,581,588 ** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 39,883       $ 38,550       $ 39,819   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 27,743       $ 26,949       $ 30,446   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 181,093       $ 177,259       $ 176,246   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 234,514       $ 212,808       $ 193,432   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,556,779       $ 1,550,851       $ 1,165,896   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 97,492       $ 241,564         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

101


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,935,466       $ 1,071,138       $ 511,659   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 235,422       $ 242,696       $ 199,829   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,803,180       $ 2,099,443       $ 2,638,964   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 411,604       $ 408,177       $ 395,351   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.
** Prior to the Fund’s conversion from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund, the Administration fees were paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder-Fund levels; amounts shown include only the portion paid at the Feeder Fund-level.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

State Street is responsible for providing certain pricing and bookkeeping services to the Funds. The Administrator is responsible for overseeing the performance of these services and for certain other services.

Services Provided

Effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into a Financial Reporting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (the Financial Reporting Services Agreement) pursuant to which State Street provides financial reporting services to the Funds. Also effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into an Accounting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (collectively with the Financial Reporting Services Agreement, the State Street Agreements) pursuant to which State Street provides accounting services to the Funds. Effective May 1, 2010, the State Street Agreements were amended to, among other things, assign and delegate the Previous Adviser’s rights and obligations under the State Street Agreements to the Administrator. Under the State Street Agreements, each Fund (except the Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Portfolios and Masters International Equity Portfolio) pays State Street an annual fee of $38,000 paid monthly plus an additional monthly fee based on an annualized percentage rate of average daily net assets of the Fund for the month. The aggregate fee for a Fund during any year shall not exceed $140,000 annually (exclusive of out-of-pocket expenses and charges). Each Fund (except the Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio and LifeGoal® Portfolios), also reimburses State Street for certain out-of-pocket expenses and charges.

Under the State Street Agreements, LifeGoal® Income Portfolio and Masters International Equity Portfolio pay State Street an annual fee of $26,000 paid monthly. LifeGoal® Income Portfolio also reimburses State Street for certain out-of-pocket expenses and charges. Except for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, the LifeGoal® Portfolios do not pay any separate fees for services rendered under the State Street Agreements, and, except for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, the fees for pricing and bookkeeping services incurred by the LifeGoal® Portfolios are paid as part of the management fee.

 

102


Table of Contents

 

Pursuant to an assumption agreement with the Adviser, Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio do not pay separate fees for services rendered under the State Street Agreements and do not pay fees for pricing and bookkeeping services.

From December 15, 2006 through May 1, 2010, the Trust was party to a Pricing and Bookkeeping Oversight and Services Agreement (the Services Agreement) with the Previous Adviser. Under the Services Agreement, the Previous Adviser provided services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and provided oversight of the accounting and financial reporting services provided by State Street. Under the Services Agreement, each Fund reimbursed the Previous Adviser for out-of-pocket expenses and charges, including fees payable to third parties, such as for pricing the Funds’ portfolio securities, incurred by the Previous Adviser in the performance of services under the Services Agreement. Prior to January 1, 2008, the Funds also reimbursed the Previous Adviser for accounting oversight services and services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Effective May 1, 2010, the services previously provided by the Previous Adviser under the Services Agreement began to be provided by the Administrator under the Administrative Services Agreement, and the Services Agreement was terminated.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Fees Paid by the Funds

The Previous Adviser and State Street received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show the net pricing and bookkeeping fees paid to State Street and to the Previous Adviser for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 117,450       $ 136,127       $ 155,666   

Global Value Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 59,373       $ 72,500       $ 101,627   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 117,947       $ 129,888       $ 142,326   

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,357       $ 141,105       $ 141,180   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 147,990       $ 144,160       $ 151,351   

Marsico Global Fund**

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 22,418       $ 16,411         N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 151,423       $ 150,412       $ 151,942   

 

103


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 145,331       $ 145,519       $ 145,051   

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,991       $ 141,486       $ 141,577   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 155,605       $ 153,963       $ 155,814   

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 15,682       $ 14,124         N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,971       $ 141,609       $ 139,589   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no pricing and bookkeeping fees prior to that date.
*** Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no pricing and bookkeeping fees prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

International Value Fund**

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 38,000       $ 38,000       $ 34,835       $ 38,000   

Large Cap Core Fund

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 144,815       $ 144,115       $ 34,834       $ 38,000   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 143,765       $ 143,367       $ 34,834       $ 38,000   

Marsico Growth Fund***

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 143,813       $ 60,038       $ 38,309       $ 38,000   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 89,209       $ 100,308       $ 34,834       $ 38,000   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.
** The Pricing and Bookkeeping Fees are paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder Fund-levels; amounts shown above include only the portion paid at the Feeder Fund-level.
*** Marsico Growth Fund converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund on November 10, 2008. All amounts shown prior to that date are only the portion that was paid at the Feeder Fund-level.

 

104


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 69,984       $ 73,930       $ 78,683   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 89,890       $ 93,328       $ 72,662   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 68,821       $ 66,874       $ 64,146   

High Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 169,120       $ 159,698       $ 46,793   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 8,032   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 26,283       $ 26,128       $ 26,000   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 74,271       $ 73,866       $ 73,668   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 8,032   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 26,284       $ 26,151       $ 23,027   

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 84,310       $ 77,582       $ 76,676   

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 170,978       $ 171,635       $ 159,889   

 

105


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 184,672       $ 159,109       $ 108,490   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 81,480       $ 81,703       $ 74,147   

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 187,866       $ 191,276       $ 198,744   

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 107,431       $ 105,618       $ 103,264   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (the Distributor) serves as the principal underwriter and distributor for the continuous offering of shares of the Funds pursuant to a Distribution Agreement. The Distribution Agreement obligates the Distributor to use appropriate efforts to find purchasers for the shares of the Funds. The Distributor’s address is: One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111.

Distribution Obligations

Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, as agent, sells shares of the Funds on a continuous basis and transmits purchase and redemption orders that it receives to the Trust or the Transfer Agent, or their designated agents. Additionally, the Distributor has agreed to use appropriate efforts to solicit orders for the sale of shares and to undertake advertising and promotion as it believes appropriate in connection with such solicitation. Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, at its own expense, finances those activities which are primarily intended to result in the sale of shares of the Funds, including, but not limited to, advertising, compensation of underwriters, dealers and sales personnel, the printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than existing shareholders, and the printing and mailing of sales literature. The Distributor, however, may be compensated or reimbursed for all or a portion of such expenses to the extent permitted by a Distribution Plan adopted by the Trust pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Distribution and Servicing Plans for more information about the share classes for which the Trust has adopted a Distribution Plan.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

The Distribution Agreement became effective with respect to each Fund after approval by its Board, and, after an initial two-year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Distribution Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Distribution Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to each Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Distributor on 60 days’ written notice.

 

106


Table of Contents

 

Underwriting Commissions Paid by the Funds

The Previous Distributor received commissions and other compensation for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show amounts paid to the Previous Distributor, as well as amounts the Previous Distributor retained, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 44,314       $ 45,753       $ 112,195   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 6,663       $ 7,725       $ 19,691   

Class B shares

   $ 15,863       $ 64,574       $ 117,174   

Class C shares

   $ 141       $ 2,957       $ 4,789   

Global Value Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 5       $ 534       $ 516   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —         $ 77       $ 74   

Class B shares

   $ 2,301       $ 15,805       $ 22,822   

Class C shares

     —         $ 58       $ 368   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Class R shares

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 15       $ 446         —     

Class B shares

   $ 4,216       $ 14,227         —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 153,445       $ 178,936       $ 353,351   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 25,081       $ 29,956       $ 60,814   

Class B shares

   $ 57,696       $ 221,885       $ 492,464   

Class C shares

   $ 1,728       $ 2,847       $ 6,649   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 813,469       $ 4,159,043       $ 12,947,491   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 120,518       $ 683,537       $ 2,024,258   

Class B shares

   $ 402,871       $ 516,184       $ 289,032   

Class C shares

   $ 144,216       $ 531,406       $ 345,480   

 

107


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Marsico Global Fund**

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 12,606       $ 6,062         N/A   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,779       $ 696         N/A   

Class C shares

   $ 743       $ 606         N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 69,193       $ 302,677       $ 895,581   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 10,762       $ 54,459       $ 172,178   

Class B shares

   $ 38,709       $ 72,437       $ 46,425   

Class C shares

   $ 4,361       $ 20,577       $ 18,926   

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 267,654       $ 770,465       $ 2,497,114   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 45,628       $ 127,913       $ 404,357   

Class B shares

   $ 88,854       $ 191,561       $ 281,240   

Class C shares

   $ 20,739       $ 82,583       $ 69,456   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 13,134       $ 29,574       $ 56,978   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 2,007       $ 4,955       $ 10,323   

Class B shares

   $ 1,146       $ 2,895       $ 4,383   

Class C shares

     —         $ 155       $ 794   

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Amount Paid

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Retained

     —           —           N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

 

108


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 8,583       $ 69,290       $ 369,025   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,118       $ 13,657       $ 59,495   

Class B shares

   $ 8,191       $ 13,646       $ 7,183   

Class C shares

   $ 1,745       $ 18,619       $ 11,554   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no underwriting commissions prior to that date.
*** Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no underwriting commissions prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

International Value Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 242,634       $ 684       $ 3,365       $ 4,037   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 34,160       $ 123       $ 514       $ 2,873   

Class B shares

   $ 507       $ 6,436       $ 21,443       $ 68,082   

Class C shares

   $ 827       $ 241       $ 246       $ 2,382   

Large Cap Core Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 42,420       $ 51,581       $ 55,167       $ 63,329   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 6,503       $ 8,300       $ 7,051       $ 9,738   

Class B shares

   $ 3,239       $ 4,423       $ 7,596       $ 12,538   

Class C shares

   $ 203       $ 128       $ 1,173       $ 3   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 264,977       $ 416,549       $ 789,688       $ 1,182,320   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 44,751       $ 70,078       $ 120,841       $ 181,454   

Class B shares

   $ 118,597       $ 207,952       $ 205,714       $ 390,545   

Class C shares

   $ 24,741       $ 58,825       $ 57,001       $ 76,216   

Marsico Growth Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 341,752       $ 577,560       $ 1,548,919       $ 1,901,364   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 66,515       $ 93,405       $ 219,479       $ 293,009   

Class B shares

   $ 119,246       $ 215,743       $ 130,863       $ 223,664   

Class C shares

   $ 43,937       $ 157,908       $ 105,184       $ 145,140   

 

109


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

Small Cap Growth Fund II

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 21,406       $ 38,170       $ 64,488       $ 66,395   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 12,949       $ 3,046       $ 6,108       $ 10,204   

Class B shares

   $ 1,948       $ 6,115       $ 11,977       $ 21,722   

Class C shares

   $ 551       $ 795       $ 1,423       $ 513   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 18,211       $ 23,096       $ 40,023   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 2,904       $ 3,460       $ 6,401   

Class B shares

   $ 502       $ 6,156       $ 4,775   

Class C shares

   $ 12       $ 350       $ 115   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Shares

     —           —           —     

High Income Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 159,763       $ 109,439       $ 193,929   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 19,213       $ 18,628       $ 23,028   

Class B shares

   $ 28,742       $ 70,082       $ 154,792   

Class C shares

   $ 5,225       $ 4,660       $ 4,914   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 707,466       $ 824,098       $ 1,678,950   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 112,738       $ 132,234       $ 288,116   

Class B shares

   $ 220,799       $ 479,481       $ 556,817   

Class C shares

   $ 6,080       $ 56,297       $ 30,593   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 357,761       $ 619,512       $ 1,467,904   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 54,808       $ 99,409       $ 252,171   

Class B shares

   $ 109,835       $ 230,340       $ 294,499   

Class C shares

   $ 6,240       $ 14,107       $ 28,334   

 

110


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 161,707       $ 248,920       $ 376,066   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 27,891       $ 45,674       $ 63,391   

Class B shares

   $ 43,762       $ 137,664       $ 125,774   

Class C shares

   $ 2,141       $ 9,112       $ 7,352   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 12,780       $ 20,370       $ 28,029   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,355       $ 1,738       $ 2,616   

Class B shares

   $ 6,709       $ 5,919       $ 11,651   

Class C shares

   $ 145       $ 1,609       $ 26   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 22,038       $ 125,854       $ 385,492   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 17,969       $ 21,250       $ 66,088   

Class B shares

   $ 14,287       $ 19,308       $ 17,122   

Class C shares

   $ 588       $ 6,443       $ 7,687   

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Shares

     —           —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 243,246       $ 70,381       $ 10,094   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 99,958       $ 19,312       $ 2,260   

Class B shares

   $ 4,116       $ 2,819       $ 4,984   

Class C shares

   $ 33,731       $ 14,417       $ 1,919   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 338,947       $ 163,550       $ 145   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 262,334       $ 56,320       $ 32   

Class B shares

     —           —           —     

Class C shares

   $ 30,159       $ 4,996       $ 203   

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 16,557       $ 14,461       $ 7,265   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,585       $ 1,258       $ 795   

Class B shares

   $ 2,468       $ 8,232       $ 7,327   

Class C shares

   $ 420       $ 278       $ 600   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

111


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Period Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 13,765       $ 13,086       $ 1,585   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 4,013       $ 21,316       $ 162   

Class B shares

   $ 991       $ 1,377       $ 540   

Class C shares

   $ 828       $ 406         —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 32,915       $ 4,631       $ 7,927   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 3,025       $ 454       $ 839   

Class B shares

   $ 582         —         $ 2,301   

Class C shares

   $ 462         —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 71,197       $ 31,838       $ 11,083   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 6,775       $ 3,179       $ 1,176   

Class B shares

   $ 485       $ 283       $ 654   

Class C shares

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 31,713       $ 21,324       $ 6,097   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 13,321       $ 2,537       $ 669   

Class B shares

   $ 713       $ 229       $ 2,893   

Class C shares

   $ 409         —         $ 263   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 53,622       $ 18,959       $ 4,052   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 24,755       $ 7,258       $ 345   

Class B shares

     —           —         $ 1,134   

Class C shares

   $ 322       $ 141       $ 1,210   

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 28,594       $ 22,633       $ 21,118   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 3,230       $ 2,300       $ 2,173   

Class B shares

   $ 698       $ 97       $ 1.746   

Class C shares

   $ 970       $ 947       $ 21   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

112


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

  Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

As described above in the Investment Advisory and Other Services section of this SAI, and in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Adviser, Administrator, Distributor and Transfer Agent, all affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, receive compensation from the Funds for the various services they provide to the Funds. Additional information as to the specific terms regarding such compensation is set forth in these affiliated service providers’ contracts with the Funds, each of which typically is included as an exhibit to Part C of each Fund’s registration statement.

In many instances, the compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for the services they provide to the Funds is based, in some manner, on the size of the Funds’ assets under management. As the size of the Funds’ assets under management grows, so does the amount of compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for providing services to the Funds. This relationship between Fund assets and affiliated service provider compensation may create economic and other conflicts of interests of which Fund investors should be aware. These potential conflicts of interest, as well as additional ones, are discussed in detail below and also are addressed in other disclosure materials, including the Funds’ prospectuses. These conflicts of interest also are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials of Ameriprise Financial affiliates that make available or offer the Columbia Funds as investments in connection with their respective products and services. In addition, Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV, which it must file with the SEC as an investment adviser registered under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, provides information about the Adviser’s business, assets under management, affiliates and potential conflicts of interest. Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV is available online through the SEC’s website at www.adviserinfo.sec.gov.

Additional actual or potential conflicts of interest and certain investment activity limitations that could affect the Funds may arise from the financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including, for example, the investment advisory/management services provided for clients and customers other than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial is a major financial services company. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are engaged in a wide range of financial activities beyond the mutual fund-related activities of the Adviser, including, among others, broker/dealer (sales and trading), asset management, insurance and other financial activities. The broad range of financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may involve multiple advisory, transactional, lending, financial and other interests in securities and other instruments, and in companies, that may be bought, sold or held by the Funds. The following describes certain actual and potential conflicts of interest that may be presented.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to the Investment Advisory/Management Activities of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates in Connection With Other Advised/Managed Funds and Accounts

The Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may advise or manage funds and accounts other than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may provide investment advisory/management and other services to other advised/managed funds and accounts that are similar to those provided to the Funds. The Adviser and Ameriprise Financial’s other investment adviser affiliates (including, for example, Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC) will give advice to and make decisions for all advised/managed funds and accounts, including the Funds, as they believe to be in that fund’s and/or account’s best interests, consistent with their fiduciary duties. The Funds and the other advised/managed funds and accounts of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are separately and potentially divergently managed, and there is no assurance that any investment advice Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates give to other advised/managed funds and accounts will also be given simultaneously or otherwise to the Funds.

A variety of other actual and potential conflicts of interest may arise from the advisory relationships of the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates with other clients and customers. Advice given to the Funds and/or investment decisions made for the Funds by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may differ from, or may conflict with, advice given to and/or investment decisions made for other advised/managed

 

113


Table of Contents

funds and accounts. As a result, the performance of the Funds may differ from the performance of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. Similarly, a position taken by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, on behalf of other funds or accounts may be contrary to a position taken on behalf of the Funds. Moreover, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may take a position on behalf of other advised/managed funds and accounts, or for their own proprietary accounts, that is adverse to companies or other issuers in which the Funds are invested. For example, the Funds may hold equity securities of a company while another advised/managed fund or account may hold debt securities of the same company. If the portfolio company were to experience financial difficulties, it might be in the best interest of the Funds for the company to reorganize while the interests of the other advised/managed fund or account might be better served by the liquidation of the company. This type of conflict of interest could arise as the result of circumstances that cannot be generally foreseen within the broad range of investment advisory/management activities in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates engage.

Investment transactions made on behalf of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates also may have a negative effect on the value, price or investment strategies of the Funds. For example, this could occur if another advised/managed fund or account implements an investment decision ahead of, or at the same time as, the Funds and causes the Funds to experience less favorable trading results than they otherwise would have experienced based on market liquidity factors. In addition, the other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, including the other Columbia Funds, may have the same or very similar investment objective and strategies as the Funds. In this situation, the allocation of, and competition for, investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and/or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may create conflicts of interest especially where, for example, limited investment availability is involved. The Adviser has adopted policies and procedures addressing the allocation of investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and accounts advised by the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

Sharing of Information among Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may possess information that could be material to the management of a Fund and may not be able to, or may determine not to, share that information with the Fund, even though the information might be beneficial to the Fund. This information may include actual knowledge regarding the particular investments and transactions of other advised/managed funds and accounts, as well as proprietary investment, trading and other market research, analytical and technical models, and new investment techniques, strategies and opportunities. Depending on the context, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will have no obligation to share any such information with the Funds. In general, employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the portfolio managers of the Adviser, will make investment decisions without regard to information otherwise known by other employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and generally will have no obligation to access any such information and may, in some instances, not be able to access such information because of legal and regulatory constraints or the internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For example, if the Adviser or another Ameriprise Financial affiliate, or their respective employees, come into possession of non-public information regarding another advised/managed fund or account, they may be prohibited by legal and regulatory constraints, or internal policies and procedures, from using that information in connection with transactions made on behalf of the Funds. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

Soft Dollar Benefits

Certain products and services, commonly referred to as “soft dollar services” (including, to the extent permitted by law, research reports, economic and financial data, financial publications, proxy analysis, computer

 

114


Table of Contents

databases and other research-oriented materials), that the Adviser may receive in connection with brokerage services provided to a Fund may have the inadvertent effect of disproportionately benefiting other advised/managed funds or accounts. This could happen because of the relative amount of brokerage services provided to a Fund as compared to other advised/managed funds or accounts, as well as the relative compensation paid by a Fund.

Services Provided to Other Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may act as an investment adviser, investment manager, administrator, transfer agent, custodian, trustee, broker/dealer, agent, or in another capacity, for advised/managed funds and accounts other than the Funds, and may receive compensation for acting in such capacity. This compensation that the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates receive could be greater than the compensation Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates receive for acting in the same or similar capacity for the Funds. In addition, the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may receive other benefits, including enhancement of new or existing business relationships. This compensation and/or the benefits that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may receive from other advised/managed funds and accounts and other relationships could potentially create incentives to favor other advised/managed funds and accounts over the Funds. Trades made by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates for the Funds may be, but are not required to be, aggregated with trades made for other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. If trades are aggregated among the Funds and those other funds and accounts, the various prices of the securities being traded may be averaged, which could have the potential effect of disadvantaging the Funds as compared to the other funds and accounts with which trades were aggregated.

Proxy Voting

Although the Adviser endeavors to make all proxy voting decisions with respect to the interests of the Funds for which it is responsible in accordance with its proxy voting policies and procedures, the Adviser’s proxy voting decisions with respect to a Fund’s portfolio securities may nonetheless benefit other advised/managed funds and accounts, and/or clients, of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. The Adviser has adopted proxy voting policies and procedures that are designed to provide that all proxy voting is done in the best interests of its clients, including the Funds, without any resulting benefit or detriment to the Adviser and/or its affiliates, including Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For more information about the Adviser’s proxy voting policies and procedures, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures.

Certain Trading Activities

The directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may buy and sell securities or other investments for their own accounts, and in doing so may take a position that is adverse to the Funds. In order to reduce the possibility that such personal investment activities of the directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates will materially adversely affect the Funds, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have adopted policies and procedures, and the Funds, the Board, the Adviser and the Distributor have each adopted a Code of Ethics that addresses such personal investment activities. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Codes of Ethics.

Affiliate Transactions

Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may enter into transactions in which Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates, or companies that are deemed to be affiliates of a Fund because of, among other factors, their or their affiliates’ ownership or control of shares of the Fund, may have an interest that potentially conflicts with the interests of the Fund. For example, an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial may sell securities to a Fund from an offering in which it is an underwriter or that it owns as a dealer, subject to applicable

 

115


Table of Contents

legal and regulatory requirements. Applicable legal and regulatory requirements also may prevent a Fund from engaging in transactions with an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, or from participating in an investment opportunity in which an affiliate of a Fund participates.

Certain Investment Limitations

Regulatory and other restrictions may limit a Fund’s investment activities in various ways. For example, regulations regarding certain industries and markets, such as emerging or international markets, and certain transactions, such as those involving certain futures and derivatives as well as restrictions applicable to certain issuers (e.g., poison pills), may impose limits on the aggregate amount of investments that may be made by affiliated investors, including accounts owned or managed by the same or affiliated managers, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. In these circumstances, the Adviser may be prevented from acquiring securities for a Fund that it might otherwise prefer to acquire if the acquisition would cause the Fund and its affiliated investors to exceed an applicable limit. These types of regulatory and other applicable limits are complex and vary significantly in different contexts including, among others, from country to country, industry to industry and issuer to issuer. The Adviser has procedures in place designed to monitor potential conflicts arising from regulatory and other limits. Nonetheless, given the complexity of these limits, the Adviser and its affiliates may inadvertently breach these limits, and a Fund may therefore be required to sell securities that it might otherwise prefer to hold in order to comply with such limits. At certain times, a Fund may be restricted in its investment activities because of relationships that an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, may have with the issuers of securities. This could happen, for example, if a Fund desired to buy a security issued by a company for which Ameriprise Financial or an affiliate serves as underwriter. The internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates covering these types of restrictions and addressing similar issues also may at times restrict a Fund’s investment activities. See also About the Funds’ Investments – Certain Investment Activity Limits.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates’ Non-Advisory Relationships with Clients and Customers other than the Funds

The financial relationships that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may have with companies and other entities in which a Fund may invest can give rise to actual and potential conflicts of interest. Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may invest (a) in the securities of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or in companies in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have an equity, debt or other interest, and/or (b) in the securities of companies held by other Columbia Funds. The purchase, holding and sale of such securities by a Fund may enhance the profitability and the business interests of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or other Columbia Funds. There also may be limitations as to the sharing with the Adviser of information derived from the non-investment advisory/management activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates because of legal and regulatory constraints and internal policies and procedures (such as information barriers and ethical walls). Because of these limitations, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will not share information derived from its non-investment advisory/management activities with the Adviser.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial Affiliates’ Marketing and Use of the Columbia Funds as Investment Options

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also provide a variety of products and services that, in some manner, may utilize the Columbia Funds as investment options. For example, the Columbia Funds may be offered as investments in connection with brokerage and other securities products offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and may be utilized as investments in connection with fiduciary, investment management and other accounts offered by affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, as well as for other Columbia Funds structured as “funds of funds.” The use of the Columbia Funds in connection with other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may introduce economic and other conflicts of interest. These conflicts of interest are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials for the other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates.

 

116


Table of Contents

 

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may make payments to their affiliates in connection with the promotion and sale of the Funds’ shares, in addition to the sales-related and other compensation that these parties may receive from the Funds. As a general matter, personnel of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, do not receive compensation in connection with their sales or use of the Funds that is greater than that paid in connection with their sales of other comparable products and services. Nonetheless, because the compensation that the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may receive for providing services to the Funds is generally based on the Funds’ assets under management and those assets will grow as shares of the Funds are sold, potential conflicts of interest may exist. See Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Financial Intermediary Payments for more information.

Other Services Provided

The Transfer Agent

Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly, RiverSource Service Corporation) is the transfer agent for the Funds. The Transfer Agent is located at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111. Under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Transfer Agent provides transfer agency, dividend disbursing agency and shareholder servicing agency services to the Funds. Effective September 7, 2010, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, pay the Transfer Agent an annual transfer agency fee of $12.08 per account, payable monthly for all share classes, except for Class I shares, and, prior to September 7, 2010, paid the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) an annual transfer agency fee of $22.36 per account, payable monthly.

In addition, effective September 7, 2010, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds in an annual amount equal to 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in such omnibus accounts (other than omnibus accounts for which American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc. is the broker of record or accounts where the beneficial owner is a customer of Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., for which the Transfer Agent is reimbursed $16.00 annually, calculated monthly based on the total number of positions in such accounts at the end of such month) for all share classes, except for Class I, Class R4, and Class Y shares. For Class R4 shares, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds subject to an annual limitation of 0.05% of the net assets attributable to such shares. Prior to September 7, 2010, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, reimbursed the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent paid to financial intermediaries that maintained omnibus accounts with the Funds, subject to a cap of up to $22.36 per account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent on a per account basis and a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by such an account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent based on a percentage of net assets.

The Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, also pay certain reimbursable out-of-pocket expenses of the Transfer Agent. The Transfer Agent also may retain as additional compensation for its services revenues for fees for wire, telephone and redemption orders, IRA trustee agent fees and account transcripts due the Transfer Agent from Fund shareholders and credits (net of bank charges) earned with respect to balances in accounts the Transfer Agent maintains in connection with its services to the Funds.

 

117


Table of Contents

 

For the period January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual transfer agency fee of $17.34 per account, payable monthly. In addition, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid for the fees and expenses the Previous Transfer Agent paid to third party dealer firms that maintained omnibus accounts with certain of the Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account. For the period April 1, 2006 through December 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual fee of $17.00 per account, payable monthly. For the period November 1, 2005 through March 31, 2006, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual fee of $15.23 per account, payable monthly. For the period September 1, 2005 through December 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was entitled to reimbursement by certain Funds for the fees and expenses that the Previous Transfer Agent paid to dealer firms or transfer agents that maintained omnibus accounts with such Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.11% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account.

The Funds that offer Class R4 shares have a Plan Administration Services Agreement with the Transfer Agent. Under the agreement, the Funds pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and Health Savings Accounts (HSAs). The fee for services is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of the average daily net assets of each Fund attributable to Class R4 shares.

Transfer agency costs for each Fund are calculated separately for each of (i) Class Y shares, (ii) Class R4 shares and (iii) all other share classes (except Class I shares, which pay no transfer agency fees). The fees paid to the Transfer Agent may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval.

The Transfer Agent retains BFDS/DST, 2 Heritage Drive, North Quincy, MA 02171 as the Funds’ sub-transfer agent. BFDS/DST assists the Transfer Agent in carrying out its duties.

The Custodian

State Street, which is located at State Street Financial Center, One Lincoln Street, Boston, MA 02111, is the Funds’ Custodian. State Street is responsible for safeguarding the Funds’ cash and securities, receiving and delivering securities and collecting the Funds’ interest and dividends.

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, which is located at 125 High Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the Funds’ independent registered public accounting firm. The Funds issue unaudited financial statements semi-annually and audited financial statements annually. The financial statements for the fiscal years ended on or after March 31, 2010 contained in a Fund’s Annual Report were audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. The Board has selected PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as the independent registered public accounting firm to audit the Funds’ books and review their tax returns for the fiscal years ended on or after March 31, 2011.

The Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements are included in the annual reports to shareholders of the Funds, and are incorporated herein by reference. No other parts of the annual reports or semi-annual reports to shareholders are incorporated by reference herein. The financial statements incorporated by reference into the Funds’ prospectuses and this SAI have been so incorporated in reliance upon the report of the independent registered public accounting firm, given on its authority as an expert in auditing and accounting.

Counsel

Goodwin Procter LLP serves as legal counsel to the Trust. Its address is 901 New York Avenue N.W., Washington, DC, 20001.

 

118


Table of Contents

 

Distribution and Servicing Plans

The Trust has adopted distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans for the Class B shares, Class C shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares and Class W shares of the Funds and a combined shareholder servicing and distribution plan for Class A shares. See Capital Stock and Other Securities for information about which Funds offer which classes of shares. The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in any such shares. See the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds for details.

The table below shows the annual distribution and/or services fees (payable monthly and calculated based on an annual percentage of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees applicable to each share class:

 

      Distribution
Fee
    Service
Fee
    Combined
Total
 

Class A

     none        none        0.25 %* 

Class B

     0.75     0.25     1.00

Class C

     0.75     0.25     1.00 %a 

Class I

     none        none        none   

Class R

     0.50     b      0.50

Class R4

     none        0.25 %c      0.25 %c 

Class W

     0.25     0.25     0.25

Class Y

     none        none        none   

Class Z

     none        none        none   

 

* The Funds pay a combined distribution and service fee pursuant to their combined shareholder servicing and distribution plan for Class A shares.
a

The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares of Short Term Bond Fund so that the distribution fee does not exceed 0.31% annually and the combined distribution and service fee does not exceed 0.56% annually. This arrangement may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

b

Class R shares pay a distribution fee pursuant to a Fund’s distribution (Rule 12b-1) plan for Class R shares. The Funds do not have a shareholder service plan for Class R shares.

c

The shareholder service fees for Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a Plan Administration Services Agreement, the Funds’ Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up. and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

The shareholder servicing plans permit the Funds to compensate or reimburse servicing agents for the shareholder services they have provided. The distribution plans, adopted pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, permit the Funds to compensate or reimburse the Distributor and/or selling agents for activities or expenses primarily intended to result in the sale of the classes’ shares. Payments are made at an annual rate and paid monthly, as a percentage of average daily net assets, set from time to time by the Board, and are charged as expenses of each Fund directly to the applicable share class. A substantial portion of the expenses incurred pursuant to these plans may be paid to affiliates of the Distributor and Ameriprise Financial.

Under the shareholder servicing plan, the Board must review, at least quarterly, a written report of the amounts paid under the servicing agreements and the purposes for which those expenditures were made. The initial term of the shareholder servicing plan is one year and it will continue in effect from year to year after its initial one-year term provided that its continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a majority of the Board, including a majority of the Independent Trustees who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the shareholder servicing plan or in any agreement related to it. Any material amendment to the

 

119


Table of Contents

shareholder servicing plan must be approved in the same manner. The shareholder servicing plan is terminable at any time with respect to the Funds by a vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees.

The Trustees believe the distribution plans could be a significant factor in the growth and retention of a Fund’s assets resulting in more advantageous expense ratios and increased investment flexibility which could benefit each class of Fund shareholders. The distribution plans will continue in effect from year to year so long as continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a vote of the Trustees, including the Independent Trustees. The distribution plans may not be amended to increase the fee materially without approval by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares, and all material amendments of the distribution plans must be approved by the Trustees in the manner provided in the foregoing sentence. The distribution plans may be terminated at any time by vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares.

Distribution and Service Fees Paid by the Funds

The Previous Distributor received distribution and service fees from the Funds for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show distribution and service fees paid to and waived by the Previous Distributor for the most recently completed fiscal year, except as otherwise indicated. The Trust is not aware as to what amount, if any, of the distribution and service fees paid to the Distributor and Previous Distributor were, on a Fund-by-Fund basis, used for advertising, printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than current shareholders, compensation to broker-dealers, compensation to sales personnel, or interest, carrying or other financing charges. Class Y shares and Class Z shares do not pay distribution and service fees.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended February 28, 2010*

 

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Convertible Securities Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 452,015         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 217,252       $ 151,485         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 72,417       $ 50,495         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Global Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 43,756         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 60,336       $ 175,288         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 20,112       $ 58,429         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

International Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 839,422         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 117,908       $ 471,362         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 39,414       $ 157,299         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

 

120


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Large Cap Core Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 308,472         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 25,822       $ 16,769         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 8,610       $ 5,586         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 29,925         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         N/A       $ 365   

Service Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         N/A         —     

Large Cap Index Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 450,571         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 28,498         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 9,500         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           N/A         N/A   

Large Cap Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 2,116,593         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 931,465       $ 278,193       $ 1,043   

Service Fee

     —         $ 310,488       $ 92,731         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Marsico 21st Century Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 5,312,864         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 865,694       $ 5,219,447       $ 229,926   

Service Fee

     —         $ 288,564       $ 1,739,815         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 3,765,167         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 520,025       $ 2,265,084         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 173,342       $ 755,028         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Marsico Global Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 4,057         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 8,834       $ 4,318   

Service Fee

     —           N/A       $ 2,945         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           —     

Marsico Growth Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 4,043,631         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 377,764       $ 3,184,187       $ 65,356   

Service Fee

     —         $ 125,921       $ 1,061,396         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

 

121


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 554,223         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 141,837       $ 353,171       $ 15,664   

Service Fee

     —         $ 47,279       $ 117,724         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Mid Cap Index Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 297,022         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Mid Cap Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 3,275,124         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 555,246       $ 1,337,147       $ 1,054,475   

Service Fee

     —         $ 183,887       $ 443,036         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 58,172         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 9,896       $ 13,300       $ 992   

Service Fee

     —         $ 3,299       $ 4,433         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Overseas Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         —           —     

Service Fee

     —           N/A         —           —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 295,265         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 27,741       $ 19,673         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 9,242       $ 6,551         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 166,219         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Small Cap Value Fund II

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 869,827         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 22,185       $ 188,396       $ 103,273   

Service Fee

     —         $ 7,388       $ 62,797         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

 

122


Table of Contents

 

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2010*

 

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares      Shares  

Asset Allocation Fund II

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 169,852         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 17,494       $ 5,233         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 5,831       $ 1,744         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 43,341         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 1,855       $ 11,515         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 618       $ 3,839         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 43,782         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 9,036       $ 22,158         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 3,015       $ 7,386         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

High Income Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 248,940         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 280,926       $ 168,507         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 93,642       $ 56,169         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 546,946         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 1,354,042       $ 596,938       $ 9,178         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 451,347       $ 198,979         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 391,736         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 671,947       $ 471,008       $ 6,656         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 223,982       $ 157,003         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

 

123


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares      Shares  

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 136,936         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 322,250       $ 161,951       $ 2,344         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 107,417       $ 54,049         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 33,338         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 56,642       $ 41,333         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 18,891       $ 13,781         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 64,534         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 11,470       $ 19,721         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 3,828       $ 6,571         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 138,968         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 29,802       $ 82,039       $ 150         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 9,938       $ 27,350         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 71,879         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 12,236       $ 28,699         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 4,079       $ 9,566         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Short Term Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 467,584         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 76,368       $ 532,171         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 25,456       $ 177,390         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

 

124


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares      Shares  

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 940,719         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 3,281       $ 381,034         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 1,094       $ 127,022         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 58,148         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 12,402       $ 58,377         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 4,126       $ 19,458         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Total Return Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 48,959         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 35,210       $ 29,886         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 11,737       $ 9,962         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 127,074         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 14,232       $ 16,153         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 4,759       $ 5,385         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

The Distributor may use the entire amount of its fees to defray the costs of commissions and service fees paid to selling and/or servicing agents and for certain other purposes. Since the distribution and service fees are payable regardless of the Distributor’s expenses, the Distributor may realize a profit from the fees. The distribution plans authorize any other payments by the Funds to the Distributor and its affiliates (including the Adviser) to the extent that such payments might be construed to be indirectly financing the distribution of a Fund’s shares. There were no unreimbursed expenses incurred under the distribution plans in the previous fiscal year to be carried over to the current fiscal year.

The Funds participate in joint distribution activities with other Columbia Funds. The fees paid under a distribution plan adopted by a Fund may be used to finance the distribution of the shares of other Columbia Funds. Such distribution costs are allocated based on the relative net asset size of the respective Funds.

Expense Limitations

The Adviser has voluntarily agreed to reimburse a portion of the Funds’ expenses so that the Funds’ ordinary operating expenses (excluding any distribution and service fees, brokerage commissions, interest, taxes

 

125


Table of Contents

and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any) after giving effect to any balance credits from the Funds’ custodian, do not exceed the following percentages:

 

Fund

   Expenses as a Percent of
Average Daily Net Assets
on an  Annualized Basis
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended February 28

  

Convertible Securities Fund

     0.95

Global Value Fund*

     1.35

International Value Fund

     1.35

Large Cap Core Fund

     1.00

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund*

     0.70

Large Cap Index Fund*

     0.14

Large Cap Value Fund

     1.00

Marsico 21st Century Fund

     1.20

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

     1.20

Marsico Global Fund

     N/A   

Marsico Growth Fund

     1.20

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

     1.50

Mid Cap Index Fund

     0.20

Mid Cap Value Fund

     1.05

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

     1.35

Overseas Value Fund

     1.35

Small Cap Growth Fund II*

     1.10

Small Cap Index Fund*

     0.20

Small Cap Value Fund II*

     1.10

 

Fund

   Expenses as a Percent of
Average Daily Net Assets
on an  Annualized Basis
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

     0.95

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     N/A   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

High Income Fund

     1.00

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     N/A   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     0.00

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

     N/A   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Short Term Bond Fund

     0.48

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.50

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Total Return Bond Fund*

     0.70

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

 

* The Adviser is entitled to recover from the Fund any fees waived or expenses reimbursed for a three year period following the date of such waiver or reimbursement if such recovery does not cause the Fund’s expenses to exceed the expense limitations in effect at the time of recovery.

 

126


Table of Contents

 

These arrangements may be modified or terminated by the Adviser at any time.

For Short Term Bond Fund, the Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares so that it does not exceed 0.31% annually. This arrangement may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

Advisory Fee Waiver for Certain Funds – Period ending June 30, 2011

The Adviser has contractually agreed to waive a portion of the investment advisory fee for Marsico 21st Century Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Marsico Growth Fund and Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund through June 30, 2011 in an amount that is calculated based on the difference between the subadvisory fees that would have been payable to Marsico based on the subadvisory fee rates then in effect immediately prior to January 1, 2008 and the fees payable to Marsico under the current subadvisory fee rates. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Subadviser(s) and Investment Subadvisory Services for information on the subadvisory fee rates.

Advisory Fee Waiver for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio – Period ending July 31, 2011

The Adviser has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of LifeGoal® Income Portfolio’s expenses through July 31, 2011 so that the Portfolio’s ordinary operating expenses (excluding any distribution and service fees, brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, and expenses associated with the Portfolio’s investments in other investment companies, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Portfolio’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages:

 

Portfolio

   Expenses as a Percent of Average Daily Net Assets
on an Annualized Basis
 

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio (Portfolio-level commitment)

     0.42

Advisory/Administration Fee Waivers for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio – Period ending July 31, 2011

 

Portfolio

   Advisory Waivers     Administration Waivers  

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     0.10 %1      0.10 %2 

 

1

The Adviser shall waive advisory fees payable to it under the Investment Management Services Agreement on assets invested in individual securities, Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage-and Asset-Backed Portfolio.

2

The Adviser shall waive administration fees payable to it under the Administration Agreement on assets invested in other Columbia Funds (Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage-and Asset-Backed Portfolio are not considered Columbia Funds).

Codes of Ethics

The Funds, the Adviser, the subadvisers and the Distributor have adopted Codes of Ethics pursuant to the requirements of the 1940 Act, including Rule 17j–1 under the 1940 Act. These Codes of Ethics permit personnel subject to the Codes of Ethics to invest in securities, including securities that may be bought or held by the Funds. These Codes of Ethics are included as exhibits to Part C of the Funds’ registration statement. These Codes of Ethics can be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room and may be obtained by calling the SEC at 202.551.8090; they also are available on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, and may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request to publicinfo@sec.gov or by writing to the SEC’s Public Reference Section, Washington, D.C. 20549–1520.

 

127


Table of Contents

 

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

The Funds have delegated to the Adviser, or as applicable, the subadviser, the responsibility to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Funds. In deciding to delegate this responsibility to the Adviser, the Board reviewed and approved the policies and procedures adopted by the Adviser and, as applicable, a subadviser. These included the procedures that the Adviser follows when a vote presents a conflict between the interests of the Funds and their shareholders and the Adviser (or subadviser), its affiliates, its other clients or other persons.

The Adviser’s policy is to vote all proxies for Fund securities in a manner considered by the Adviser to be in the best interest of the Funds and their shareholders without regard to any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser examines each proposal and votes against the proposal, if, in its judgment, approval or adoption of the proposal would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities. The Adviser also examines each proposal and votes the proxies against the proposal, if, in its judgment, the proposal would be expected to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. The Adviser determines the best interest of the Funds in light of the potential economic return on each Fund’s investment.

The Adviser seeks to address potential material conflicts of interest by having predetermined voting guidelines. For those proposals that require special consideration or in instances where special circumstances may require varying from the predetermined guideline, the Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee determines the vote in the best interest of the Funds, without consideration of any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee is composed of representatives of the Adviser’s equity investments, equity research, compliance, legal and operations functions. In addition to the responsibilities described above, the Proxy Voting Committee has the responsibility to review, at least annually, the Adviser’s proxy voting policies to ensure consistency with internal policies and regulatory requirements and to develop additional predetermined voting guidelines to assist in the review of proxy proposals.

The Proxy Voting Committee may vary from a predetermined guideline if it determines that voting on the proposal according to the predetermined guideline would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities or to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. References to the best interests of the Funds refer to the interest of the Funds in terms of the potential economic return on the client’s investment. In determining the vote on any proposal, the Proxy Voting Committee does not consider any benefit other than benefits to the Funds. A member of the Proxy Voting Committee is prohibited from voting on any proposal for which he or she has a conflict of interest by reason of a direct relationship with the issuer or other party affected by a given proposal. Persons making recommendations to the Proxy Voting Committee or its members are required to disclose to the Committee any relationship with a party making a proposal or other matter known to the person that would create a potential conflict of interest.

The Adviser has retained Glass-Lewis & Co., a third-party vendor, to implement its proxy voting process. Glass-Lewis & Co. provides proxy analysis, record keeping services and vote disclosure services. Information regarding how the Columbia Funds (except certain Columbia Funds that do not invest in voting securities) voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent twelve month period ended June 30 will be available by August 31 of this year free of charge: (i) through the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com and (ii) on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. For a copy of the Adviser’s and subadvisers’ policies and procedures that are used to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Columbia Funds, see Appendix B to this SAI.

Expenses Paid by Third Parties

The Distributor and the Administrator furnish, without additional cost to the Funds, the services of certain officers of the Funds and such other personnel (other than the personnel of the Adviser or the investment

 

128


Table of Contents

subadviser(s), if applicable) as are required for the proper conduct of the Funds’ affairs. The Distributor bears the incremental expenses of printing and distributing prospectuses used by the Distributor or furnished by the Distributor to investors in connection with the public offering of the Funds’ shares and the costs of any other promotional or sales literature, except that to the extent permitted under the Distribution Plans of each Fund, sales-related expenses incurred by the Distributor may be reimbursed by the Funds.

The Funds pay or cause to be paid all other expenses of the Funds, including, without limitation: the fees of the Adviser, the Distributor and the Administrator; the charges and expenses of any registrar, any custodian or depository appointed by the Funds for the safekeeping of their cash, Fund securities and other property, and any stock transfer, dividend or accounting agent or agents appointed by the Funds; brokerage commissions chargeable to the Funds in connection with Fund securities transactions to which the Funds are a party; all taxes, including securities issuance and transfer taxes; corporate fees payable by the Funds to federal, state or other governmental agencies; all costs and expenses in connection with the registration and maintenance of registration of the Funds’ shares with the SEC and various states and other jurisdictions (including filing fees, legal fees and disbursements of counsel); the costs and expenses of preparing and typesetting prospectuses and statements of additional information of the Funds (including supplements thereto) and periodic reports and of printing and distributing such prospectuses and statements of additional information (including supplements thereto) to the Funds’ shareholders; all expenses of shareholders’ and Trustee meetings and of preparing, printing and mailing proxy statements and reports to shareholders; fees and travel expenses of directors or director members of any advisory board or committee; all expenses incident to the payment of any distribution, whether in shares or cash; charges and expenses of any outside service used for pricing of the Funds’ shares; fees and expenses of legal counsel and of independent auditors in connection with any matter relating to the Funds; membership dues of industry associations; interest payable on Fund borrowings; postage and long-distance telephone charges; insurance premiums on property or personnel (including officers and directors) of the Funds which inure to their benefit; extraordinary expenses (including, but not limited to, legal claims and liabilities and litigation costs and any indemnification related thereto); and all other charges and costs of the Funds’ operation unless otherwise explicitly assumed by the Adviser or the Administrator.

The Adviser has agreed to bear all fees and expenses of Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio and LifeGoal® Growth and Income Portfolio except taxes, brokerage fees and commissions, costs, including interest expenses, of borrowing money, extraordinary expenses and any applicable 12b-1 fees, shareholder servicing fees and/or shareholder administration fees. The expenses borne by the Adviser include custodian, transfer agent, legal and audit fees and costs, expenses of issue, sale, redemption and repurchase of shares, expenses of registering and qualifying shares for sale, expenses relating to trustee and shareholder meetings, the cost of preparing and distributing reports and notices to shareholders, and the cost of preparing and printing prospectuses and SAIs distributed to the Portfolios’ shareholders. This assumption does not include advisory fees to the Adviser.

Expenses of the Funds which are not attributable to the operations of any class of shares or Fund are pro-rated among all classes of shares or certain Columbia Funds, including the Funds based upon the relative net assets of each class or Fund. Expenses which are not directly attributable to a specific class of shares but are attributable to a specific Fund are prorated among all the classes of shares of such Fund based upon the relative net assets of each such class of shares. Expenses which are directly attributable to a class of shares are charged against the income available for distribution as dividends to such class of shares.

 

129


Table of Contents

 

FUND GOVERNANCE

The Board

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

The Board oversees management of the Trust and the Funds. The Board has a duty to act in the best interest of shareholders when supervising and overseeing the management and operations of the Trust. The Board consists of seven Trustees who have extensive and varied experience and skills. Six of the Trustees are Independent Trustees. The Trust currently treats the remaining Trustee, Dr. Anthony M. Santomero, as an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Columbia Funds (the Interested Trustee) because he serves as a Director of Citigroup, Inc. and CitiBank N.A. companies that may engage from time-to-time in brokerage execution, principal transactions and lending relationships with the Funds or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser. Further information about the background and qualifications of each of the Trustees can be found in the section Trustee Biographical Information and Qualifications.

The Board has appointed an Independent Trustee to serve in the role of Chairman. The Chairman actively participates in the development of the agendas for Board meetings, presides at Board Meetings and acts as a liaison with service providers, officers, attorneys, and other Trustees generally between meetings. The Chairman may also perform such other functions as may be delegated by the Board from time to time. Except for any duties specified herein or pursuant to the Trust’s charter document, the designation of Chairman does not impose on such Independent Trustee any duties, obligations or liability that are greater than the duties, obligations or liability imposed on such person as a member of the Board generally.

The Board has several standing committees (the Committees), which are an integral part of the Funds’ overall governance and risk management oversight structure. The standing Committees are the Audit Committee, the Governance Committee, the Contracts Review Committee and the Investment Committee. The roles of each Committee are more fully described in the section Standing Committees below.

The Funds have retained the Adviser as the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator. The Adviser provides the Funds with investment advisory services, and is responsible for day-to-day management and administration of the Funds and management of the risks that arise from the Funds’ investments and operations. The Board is responsible for overseeing the Adviser and other service providers in the operation of the Trust, including with respect to risk management functions. The Funds and the Trust are subject to a number of risks, including investment, compliance, operational, and valuation risks, among others. Day-to-day risk management functions are subsumed within the responsibilities of the Adviser, the subadvisers and other service providers (depending on the nature of the risk), who carry out the Funds’ investment management and business affairs. Each of the Adviser, the subadvisers and other service providers have their own, independent interest in risk management, and their policies and methods of carrying out risk management functions will depend, in part, on their analysis of the risks, functions and business models.

Risk oversight forms part of the Board’s general oversight of the Funds and the Trust and is addressed as part of various Board and Committee activities. The Board recognizes that it is not possible to identify all of the risks that may affect a Fund or to develop processes and controls to eliminate or even mitigate their occurrence or effects. As part of its regular oversight of the Trust, the Board, directly or through a Committee, interacts with and reviews reports from, among others, the Adviser, subadvisers, the independent registered public accounting firm for the Fund, and internal auditors for the Adviser or its affiliates, as appropriate, regarding risks faced by the Funds and relevant risk functions. The Board and the Audit Committee also meet periodically with the Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, to receive reports regarding the compliance of the Funds and their principal service providers with the federal securities laws and their internal compliance policies and procedures. The Board and the Audit Committee review and approve the compliance program of the Fund and certain of its service providers, and also receive periodic and annual reports from the Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, as required under applicable regulations. The Board, with the assistance of the Investment Committee, reviews investment policies and risks in connection with its review of the Funds’ performance, and meets periodically

 

130


Table of Contents

with the portfolio managers of the Funds to receive reports regarding the management of the Funds, including their investment risks. In addition, as part of the Board’s periodic review of the Funds’ advisory, subadvisory and other service provider agreements, the Board may consider risk management aspects of their operations and the functions for which they are responsible.

The Independent Trustees have engaged independent legal counsel to assist them in performing their oversight responsibilities. The Board reviews its leadership structure periodically and believes that its structure is appropriate because it allows the Board to exercise informed and independent judgment over matters under its purview, and it allocates areas of responsibility among committees of Trustees and the full Board in a manner that enhances effective oversight. In particular, the Board believes that having an Independent Trustee serve as the chair of the Board and each Committee promotes independence from the Adviser in setting agendas and conducting meetings. The Board believes that its committee structure makes the oversight process more efficient and more effective by allowing smaller groups of Trustees to bring increased focus to matters within the purview of each Committee. The leadership structure of the Board, including the manner in which it conducts its risk oversight role, may be changed, at any time and in the discretion of the Board, including in response to changes in circumstances or the characteristics of the Trust.

Standing Committees

The Trust has four standing Committees, which are the Audit Committee, the Contracts Review Committee, the Governance Committee and the Investment Committee.

In general, the function of the Audit Committee is oversight of the financial aspects of the Trust and Funds and approval of and interaction with the Funds’ Independent Auditors. Management (which generally means the appropriate officers of the Trust, and a Fund’s investment adviser(s), administrator(s) and other key service providers (other than the independent registered public accounting firm)) is primarily responsible for the preparation of the financial statements of each Fund, and the independent registered public accounting firm is responsible for auditing those financial statements. Management also is responsible for maintaining appropriate systems for accounting and “internal controls over financial reporting” (as such term is defined in Rule 30a-3 under the 1940 Act), and the independent registered public accounting firm is primarily responsible for considering such internal controls over financial reporting in connection with its financial statement audits. While the Audit Committee has the duties and powers set forth in the Audit Committee charter, the Audit Committee is not responsible for planning or conducting any Fund audit or for determining whether a Fund’s financial statements are complete and accurate and are in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

The Audit Committee has, among other things, specific power and responsibility to: (i) oversee its Funds’ accounting and financial reporting processes and practices, its internal controls over financial reporting and, as appropriate, the internal controls over financial reporting of the Funds maintained by key service providers; (ii) approve, and recommend to the full Board for its approval in accordance with applicable law, the selection and appointment of an independent registered public accounting firm for the Fund prior to the engagement of such independent registered public accounting firm; (iii) pre-approve all audit and non-audit services provided to a Fund by its independent registered public accounting firm, directly or by establishing pre-approval policies and procedures pursuant to which such services may be rendered, provided however, that the policies and procedures are detailed as to the particular service and the Audit Committee is informed of each service, and such policies do not include the delegation to management of the Audit Committee’s responsibilities under the 1934 Act or applicable rules or listing requirements; and (iv) pre-approve all non-audit services provided by a Fund’s independent registered public accounting firm to the Fund’s investment adviser and any entity controlling, controlled by, or under common control with the investment adviser that provides ongoing services to a Fund, if the engagement relates directly to the operations and financial reporting of a Fund. The members of the Audit Committee are William A. Hawkins (Chair), Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. and William P. Carmichael. The Audit Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

 

131


Table of Contents

 

The primary responsibilities of the Contracts Review Committee, as set forth in its charter, include reviewing and making recommendations to the Board as to: (i) contractual arrangements; (ii) the factors considered in approving investment advisory and the investment subadvisory agreements; and (iii) service provider oversight and performance. Among other responsibilities, the Contracts Review Committee also oversees and coordinates activities of consultants and legal or financial experts that may be engaged under certain circumstances. The members of the Contracts Review Committee are R. Glenn Hilliard (Chair), William P. Carmichael, John J. Nagorniak and Anthony M. Santomero. With the exception of the Interested Trustee, the Contracts Review Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

The primary responsibilities of the Governance Committee include, as set forth in its charter: (i) nominating Independent Trustees; (ii) overseeing issues of corporate governance for the Trust and the Funds; (iii) addressing matters relating to compensation of Trustees who are not current directors, officers or employees of a Fund’s investment adviser or subadviser or any control affiliate thereof, including deferred compensation and retirement policies; and (iv) evaluating each Board and its committee structure as often as it deems necessary or desirable to determine whether each is functioning effectively. The Governance Committee shall determine the nature of the evaluation and its role therein in its sole discretion. The members of the Governance Committee are Minor M. Shaw (Chair), William A. Hawkins, R. Glenn Hilliard and William P. Carmichael (ex officio). The Governance Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

The primary responsibilities of the Investment Committee are, as set forth in its charter, to assist the Board in carrying out its oversight responsibilities in specific areas of investment management, both by acting as liaison between the full Board and the Adviser on investment matters, and by acting on behalf of the Board with respect to investment issues in extraordinary circumstances when it is impractical to convene a meeting of the full Board. In carrying out these general responsibilities, the Investment Committee assists the Board in connection with issues relating to: the investment policies and procedures adopted for each Fund; appropriate performance benchmarks and other comparative issues; portfolio management staffing and other personnel issues of the Adviser; investment related compliance issues; possible exemptive applications or other relief necessary or appropriate with respect to investment matters; and other investment related matters referred from time to time to the Committee by the full Board. The Committee reports its activities to the full Board on a regular basis and is responsible for making such recommendations with respect to the matters described above and other matters as the Committee may deem necessary or appropriate. The Chairperson of the Investment Committee is Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Each Trustee is a member of the Investment Committee. With the exception of the Interested Trustee, the Investment Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

The table below shows the number of times the committees met during each Fund’s most recent fiscal year. The table is organized by fiscal year end.

 

Fiscal Period

   Audit Committee      Contracts Review
Committee
     Governance
Committee
     Investment
Committee
 

For Funds with fiscal years ending February 28

     5         4         7         7   

For Funds with fiscal years ending March 31

     5         4         7         7   

The Trust’s Declaration of Trust does not set forth any specific qualifications to serve as a Trustee other than that each Trustee shall be an individual of at least 21 years of age who is not under a legal disability. The Charter of the Governance Committee also does not set forth any specific qualifications, but does set forth certain factors that the Committee may take into account in considering Trustee candidates. Among the attributes or skills common to all Trustees are their ability to review critically, evaluate, question and discuss information provided to them, to interact effectively with the other Trustees, the Adviser, subadvisers, other service providers, counsel and the independent registered public accounting firm, and to exercise effective and independent business judgment in the performance of their duties as Trustees. Each Trustee’s ability to perform his or her duties effectively has been attained through: (i) the individual’s business and professional experience and accomplishments; (ii) the individual’s experience working with the other Trustees and management; (iii) the

 

132


Table of Contents

individual’s prior experience, if any, serving on the boards of public companies (including, where relevant, other investment companies) and other complex enterprises and organizations; and (iv) his or her educational background, professional training, and/or other life experiences. Generally, no one factor was decisive in determining that an individual should serve as a Trustee.

Following is a summary of each Trustee’s particular professional and other experience that qualifies each person to serve as a Trustee of the Trust as of the date of this SAI:

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Mr. Boudreau has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2005. In addition, he has over thirty years of business and consulting experience, primarily in the financial services industry, including as the chief executive of a mutual fund management company.

William P. Carmichael. Mr. Carmichael has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 1999, and has served as Chairman of the Board of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2003. Mr. Carmichael served in various senior financial and directorship positions with global consumer products companies. Mr. Carmichael is a certified public accountant and a licensed attorney.

William A. Hawkins. Mr. Hawkins has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2005. He currently serves as the President and Chief Executive Officer of California General Bank and has over thirty years of executive level experience in the banking industry. Mr. Hawkins is a certified financial planner and a chartered property and casualty underwriter, as well as holding series 7, 24 and 63 licenses from the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

R. Glenn Hilliard. Mr. Hilliard has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2005. Mr. Hilliard is currently the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of The Hilliard Group, LLC. He has over twenty years executive level experience in the insurance industry. Mr. Hilliard has served on the Board of Directors and as non-executive chairman of Conseco, Inc. for a number of years. Mr. Hilliard is also a licensed attorney.

John J. Nagorniak. Mr. Nagorniak has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2008. Mr. Nagorniak has served in executive level and director positions for over twenty-five years. He is a chartered financial analyst and is currently a Trustee of the Research Foundation of the CFA Institute.

Minor M. Shaw. Ms. Shaw has served as a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2003. Ms. Shaw is the President of certain private companies and is a member of the Board of Piedmont Natural Gas and Blue Cross and Blue Shield of South Carolina. Ms. Shaw also serves as an active member on the boards of numerous educational and public service organizations.

Anthony M. Santomero. Dr. Santomero has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2008. Dr. Santomero has over thirty years of experience as a professor of finance and private consultant specializing in issues including risk management, financial restructuring, credit risk evaluation and management, and regulation. He has served as consultant to financial institutions and agencies in the U.S. and various countries in the European Union and the European Community itself, as well as institutions in various countries around the world. Additionally, Dr. Santomero has served as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia.

The following table provides additional biographical information about the Trustees as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period. The mailing address of each Trustee is: c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, One Financial Center, Mail Stop MA5-515-11-05, Boston, MA 02111.

 

133


Table of Contents

 

Independent Trustee Biographical Information

 

Name, Year of Birth and
Position Held with the Trust

 

Year First
Appointed or
Elected to a
Board in the
Columbia Funds
Complex

 

Principal
Occupation(s) During the
Past Five Years

  Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
   

Other Directorships Held
by Trustee During the
Past Five Years

Independent Trustees

       

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

(Born 1944)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since January 2005
  Managing Director – E.J. Boudreau & Associates (consulting), from 2000 through current     52      Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

William P. Carmichael

(Born 1943)

Trustee and Chairman of the Board

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since 1999
  Retired     52      Director – Cobra Electronics Corporation (electronic equipment manufacturer); Simmons Company (bedding); and The Finish Line (athletic shoes and apparel); Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios); former Director of Spectrum Brands, Inc. (consumer products)

William A. Hawkins

(Born 1942)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2005
  President and Chief Executive Officer – California Bank, N.A., from January 2008 through current     52      Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

R. Glenn Hilliard

(Born 1943)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2005
  Chairman and Chief Executive Officer – Hilliard Group LLC (investing and consulting), from April 2003 through current; Non-Executive Director & Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), September 2003 through current; Executive Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), August 2004 through September 2005     52      Director – Conseco, Inc. (insurance); Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

 

134


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and
Position Held with the Trust

 

Year First
Appointed or
Elected to a
Board in the
Columbia Funds
Complex

 

Principal
Occupation(s) During the
Past Five Years

  Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
 

Other Directorships Held
by Trustee During the
Past Five Years

John J. Nagorniak

(Born 1944)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2008
  Retired; President and Director – Foxstone Financial, Inc. (consulting), 2000 through December 2007; Director – Mellon Financial Corporation affiliates (investing), 2000 through 2007; Chairman – Franklin Portfolio Associates (investing – Mellon affiliate) 1982 through 2007   52   Trustee – Research Foundation of CFA Institute; Director – MIT Investment Company; Trustee – MIT 401k Plan; Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

Minor M. Shaw

(Born 1947)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
2003
  President – Micco Corporation and Mickel Investment Group   52   Board Member – Piedmont Natural Gas; Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

Interested Trustee Biographical Information

     

Anthony M. Santomero1

(Born 1946)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2008
  Richard K. Mellon Professor Emeritus of Finance, The Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, from 2002 through current; Senior Advisor – McKinsey & Company (consulting), 2006 through 2008; President and Chief Executive Officer – Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia, 2000 through 2006   52   Director – Renaissance Reinsurance Ltd.; Trustee – Penn Mutual Life Insurance Company; Director – Citigroup; Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

 

1

Dr. Santomero is currently deemed by the Columbia Funds to be an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds because he serves as a Director of Citigroup, Inc. and Citibank N.A., companies that may directly or through subsidiaries and affiliates engage from time-to-time in brokerage execution, principal transactions and lending relationships with the Columbia Funds or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser.

 

135


Table of Contents

 

Compensation

Trustees are compensated for their services to the Columbia Funds complex on a complex-wide basis, as shown in the table below.

 

     Aggregate Compensation from Fund  
     Independent Trustees  

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
   William P.
Carmichael2
     Minor  M.
Shaw3
     R.  Glenn
Hilliard4
     William  A.
Hawkins5
     John J.
Nagorniak6
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28

              

Convertible Securities Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Global Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

International Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Core Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Index Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico Global Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Overseas Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Small Cap Index Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

 

136


Table of Contents

 

     Aggregate Compensation from Fund  
     Independent Trustees  

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
   William P.
Carmichael2
   Minor  M.
Shaw3
     R.  Glenn
Hilliard4
     William  A.
Hawkins5
     John J.
Nagorniak6
 

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

              

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

High Income Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Short Term Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

 

137


Table of Contents
     Aggregate Compensation from Fund
     Independent Trustees

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
   William P.
Carmichael2
   Minor M.
Shaw3
   R. Glenn
Hilliard4
   William A.
Hawkins5
   John J.
Nagorniak6

Total Return Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546    $4,452    $4,530    $4,608    $3,908

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0    $2,226    $0    $83    $1,173

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546    $4,452    $4,530    $4,608    $3,908

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0    $2,226    $0    $83    $1,173

 

1

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Boudreau deferred $81,627 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Boudreau’s account under that plan was $286,846.

2

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Carmichael deferred $0 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Carmichael’s account under that plan was $1,056,273.

3

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Shaw deferred $132,587 of her total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Shaw’s account under that plan was $576,224.

4

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Hilliard deferred $31,154 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Hilliard’s account under that plan was $605,201.

5

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Hawkins deferred $0 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Hawkins’s account under that plan was $0.

6

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Nagorniak deferred $69,170 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Nagorniak’s account under that plan was $130,303.

 

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

      
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

For funds with fiscal year ending February 28

  

Convertible Securities Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Global Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

International Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Core Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Index Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

138


Table of Contents

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

      
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico Global Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Overseas Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Small Cap Index Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

For funds with fiscal year ending March 31

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

High Income Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

139


Table of Contents

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

      
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Short Term Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Total Return Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

7

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Dr. Santomero deferred $122,207 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Dr. Santomero’s account under that plan was $203,951.

Independent Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

    

Total Compensation from the
Columbia Funds Complex
Paid to Independent Trustees
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a

Independent Trustees

  

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

   $295,000

William P. Carmichael

   $357,500

Minor M. Shaw

   $287,500

R. Glenn Hilliard

   $290,000

William A. Hawkins

   $297,500

John J. Nagorniak

   $250,000

Interested Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

    

Total Compensation from the
Columbia Funds Complex
Paid to Interested Trustee
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a

Interested Trustees

  

Anthony M. Santomero

   $265,000

Columbia Funds Deferred Compensation Plan

Under the terms of the Deferred Fee Agreement (the Deferred Compensation Plan), each eligible Trustee may elect, on an annual basis, to defer receipt of all or a portion of compensation payable to him or her for

 

140


Table of Contents

service as Trustee for that calendar year. Fees deferred by a Trustee are credited to a book reserve account (the Deferral Account) established by the Columbia Funds, the value of which is derived from the rate of return of one or more Columbia Funds selected by the Trustee (with accruals to the Deferral Account beginning at such time as a Trustee’s fund elections having been established, and fees for service having been paid into such account, and terminating at such time as when proceeds become payable to such Trustee under the Deferred Compensation Plan). Trustees may change their fund elections only in accordance with the provisions of the Deferred Compensation Plan.

Distributions from a Trustee’s Deferral Account will be paid by check, either in a lump sum or in annual installments. Payments made in annual installments are disbursed over a period of up to ten years, following such time as a Trustee may qualify to receive such payments. If a deferring Trustee dies prior to or after the commencement of the disbursement of amounts accrued in his/her Deferral Account, the balance of the account will be distributed to his/her designated beneficiary either in lump sum or in annual payments as established by such Trustee himself/herself, his/her beneficiary or his/her estate. Amounts payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan are not funded or secured in any way, and each deferring Trustee has the status of an unsecured creditor of the Columbia Fund(s) selected by such Trustee.

Beneficial Equity Ownership

As of the date of this SAI, the Trustees and Officers of the Trust, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of each class of shares of each Fund. The table below shows, for each Trustee, the amount of Fund equity securities beneficially owned by the Trustee and the aggregate value of all investments in equity securities of the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustees, including notional amounts through the Deferred Compensation Plan, stated as one of the following ranges: A = $0; B = $1-$10,000; C = $10,001-$50,000; D = $50,001-$100,000; and E = over $100,000.

Independent Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.
   William P.
Carmichael
   Minor M.
Shaw
   R. Glenn
Hilliard
   William A.
Hawkins
   John J.
Nagorniak

Asset Allocation Fund II

   A    A    A    A    A    A

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Convertible Securities Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Global Value Fund

   C    A    A    A    A    A

High Income Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

International Value Fund

   A    E    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Core Fund

   C    A    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Index Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Value Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   B    D    A    A    A    A

Marsico Global Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

 

141


Table of Contents

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.
   William P.
Carmichael
   Minor M.
Shaw
   R. Glenn
Hilliard
   William A.
Hawkins
   John J.
Nagorniak

Marsico Growth Fund

   A    D    A    A    A    A

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Mid Cap Index Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Mid Cap Value Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Overseas Value Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Short Term Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   B    D    A    A    A    A

Small Cap Index Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Small Cap Value Fund II

   B    A    A    A    A    A

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Total Return Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

   E    E    E    E    A    E

Interested Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   Anthony M.
Santomero

Asset Allocation Fund II

   A

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Convertible Securities Fund

   A

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   A

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Global Value Fund

   A

High Income Fund

   A

International Value Fund

   A

Large Cap Core Fund

   A

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   A

Large Cap Index Fund

   A

Large Cap Value Fund

   A

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   A

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   A

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   A

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   A

 

142


Table of Contents

Fund

   Anthony M.
Santomero

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   A

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   A

Marsico Global Fund

   A

Marsico Growth Fund

   A

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   A

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   A

Mid Cap Index Fund

   A

Mid Cap Value Fund

   A

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   A

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   A

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Overseas Value Fund

   A

Short Term Bond Fund

   A

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   A

Small Cap Index Fund

   A

Small Cap Value Fund II

   A

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Total Return Bond Fund

   A

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

   E

The Officers

The following table provides basic information about the Officers of the Trust as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period.

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

J. Kevin Connaughton

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   President (Principal Executive Officer)    2009   

Senior Vice President and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President, Columbia Funds, since 2009, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010 (previously Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Columbia

Funds, from June 2008 to January 2009, Treasurer, Columbia Funds, from October 2003 to May 2008, and senior officer of various other affiliated funds since 2000); Managing Director, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from December 2004 to April 2010.

 

143


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Michael G. Clarke

(Born 1969)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)    2009    Vice President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Managing Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from September 2004 to April 2010; senior officer of Columbia Funds and affiliated funds since 2002.

Scott R. Plummer

(Born 1959)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer    2010    Chief Legal Officer and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since June 2005; Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, from 2005 to April 2010, and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance from 2004 to 2005); Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, RiverSource Funds, since December 2006; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since May 2010.

Linda J. Wondrack

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer    2007    Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Funds, since 2007, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, from June 2005 to April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer of MFS Investment Management (investment management) from August 2004 to May 2005.

 

144


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

William F. Truscott

(Born 1960)

53600 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Senior Vice President    2010    Chairman of the Board, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to April 2010); Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President, Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer from 2005 to April 2010, and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to 2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer from 2008 to April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006.

Colin Moore

(Born 1958)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Senior Vice President    2010    Director and Chief Investment Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2002 to 2007.

Michael A. Jones

(Born 1959)

100 Federal Street

Boston, MA 02110

   Senior Vice President    2010    Director and President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from November 2006 to April 2010; previously, co-president and senior managing director at Robeco Investment Management.

 

145


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Amy Johnson

(Born 1965)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Senior Vice President    2010    Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of the Adviser, since May 2010; Chief Administrative Officer, the Adviser from 2009 until May 2010; Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, the Adviser, 2006-2009; Vice President – Operations and Compliance, the Adviser, 2004-2006; Director of Product Development – Mutual Funds, Ameriprise Financial, 2001-2004.

Joseph F. DiMaria

(Born 1968)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Treasurer and Chief Accounting Officer    2008    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2006 to April 2010; Head of Tax/Compliance and Assistant Treasurer, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from November 2004 to December 2005.

Marybeth Pilat

(Born 1968)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Deputy Treasurer    2010    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Vice President, Investment Operations, Bank of America, from October 2008 to April 2010; Finance Manager, Boston Children’s Hospital from August 2008 to October 2008; Director, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from May 2007 to July 2008; Vice President, Mutual Fund Valuation, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from January 2006 to May 2007; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2005 to January 2006.

 

146


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Julian Quero

(Born 1967)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Deputy Treasurer    2008    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from August 2008 to April 2010; Senior Tax Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from August 2006 to July 2008; Senior Compliance Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from April 2002 to August 2006.

Stephen T. Welsh

(Born 1957)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Vice President    2006    President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Services, Inc. from July 2004 to April 2010; Managing Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from August 2007 to April 2010.

Kathryn Thompson

(Born 1967)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Assistant Treasurer    2006    Director, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight and Treasury of the Adviser, since May 2010; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight of the Previous Adviser from December 2004 to April 2010; Vice President, State Street Corporation (financial services) prior to December 2004.

Paul B. Goucher

(Born 1968)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel of Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel from November 2008 to January 2010); Director, Managing Director and General Counsel of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated (Seligman) from July 2008 to November 2008 and Managing Director and Associate General Counsel of Seligman from January 2005 to July 2008.

Ryan C. Larrenaga

(Born 1970)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Assistant Secretary    2005    Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since May 2010; Assistant General Counsel, Bank of America from March 2005 to April 2010; Associate, Ropes & Gray LLP (law firm) from 1998 to February 2005.

 

147


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Christopher O. Petersen

(Born 1970)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel or Counsel from April 2004 to January 2010); Assistant Secretary of RiverSource Funds since January 2007.

 

148


Table of Contents

 

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

Subject to policies established by the Board, the Adviser (or the investment subadviser(s) who make the day-to-day investment decisions for a Fund, as applicable) is responsible for decisions to buy and sell securities for each Fund, for the selection of broker/dealers, for the execution of a Fund’s securities transactions and for the allocation of brokerage commissions in connection with such transactions. The Adviser’s primary consideration in effecting a security transaction is to obtain the best net price and the most favorable execution of the order. Purchases and sales of securities on a securities exchange are effected through brokers who charge negotiated commissions for their services. Orders may be directed to any broker to the extent and in the manner permitted by applicable law.

In the over-the-counter market, securities generally are traded on a “net” basis with dealers acting as principals for their own accounts without stated commissions, although the price of a security usually includes a profit to the dealer. In underwritten offerings, securities are bought at a fixed price that includes an amount of compensation to the underwriter, generally referred to as the underwriter’s “concession” or “discount.” On occasion, certain money market instruments may be bought directly from an issuer, in which case no commissions or discounts are paid.

In placing orders for portfolio securities of the Funds, the Adviser gives primary consideration to obtaining the best net prices and most favorable execution. This means that the Adviser will seek to execute each transaction at a price and commission, if any, which provides the most favorable total cost or proceeds reasonably attainable in the circumstances. In seeking such execution, the Adviser will use its best judgment in evaluating the terms of a transaction, and will give consideration to various relevant factors, including, without limitation, the size and type of the transaction, the nature and character of the market for the security, the confidentiality, speed and certainty of effective execution required for the transaction, the general execution and operational capabilities of the broker/dealer, the reputation, reliability, experience and financial condition of the broker/dealer, the value and quality of the services rendered by the broker/dealer in this instance and other transactions and the reasonableness of the spread or commission, if any. Research services received from broker/dealers supplement the Adviser’s own research and may include the following types of information: statistical and background information on industry groups and individual companies; forecasts and interpretations with respect to U.S. and foreign economies, securities, markets, specific industry groups and individual companies; information on political developments; Fund management strategies; performance information on securities and information concerning prices of securities; and information supplied by specialized services to the Adviser and to the Board with respect to the performance, investment activities and fees and expenses of other mutual funds. Such information may be communicated electronically, orally or in written form. Research services also may include the arranging of meetings with management of companies and the provision of access to consultants who supply research information.

The outside research is useful to the Adviser since, in certain instances, the broker/dealers utilized by the Adviser may follow a different universe of securities issuers and other matters than those that the Adviser’s staff can follow. In addition, this research provides the Adviser with a different perspective on financial markets, even if the securities research obtained relates to issues followed by the Adviser. Research services that are provided to the Adviser by broker/dealers are available for the benefit of all accounts managed or advised by the Adviser. In some cases, the research services are available only from the broker/dealer providing such services. In other cases, the research services may be obtainable from alternative sources. The Adviser is of the opinion that because the broker/dealer research supplements rather than replaces the Adviser’s own research, the receipt of such research does not tend to decrease the Adviser’s expenses, but tends to improve the quality of its investment advice. However, to the extent that the Adviser would have bought any such research services had such services not been provided by broker/dealers, the expenses of such services to the Adviser could be considered to have been reduced accordingly. Certain research services furnished by broker/dealers may be useful to the clients of

 

149


Table of Contents

the Adviser other than the Funds. Conversely, any research services received by the Adviser through the placement of transactions of other clients may be of value to the Adviser in fulfilling its obligations to the Funds. The Adviser is of the opinion that this material is beneficial in supplementing its research and analysis; and, therefore, it may benefit the Trust by improving the quality of the Adviser’s investment advice. The advisory fees paid by the Trust are not reduced because the Adviser receives such services.

Under Section 28(e) of the 1934 Act, the Adviser shall not be “deemed to have acted unlawfully or to have breached its fiduciary duty” solely because under certain circumstances it has caused the account to pay a higher commission than the lowest available. To obtain the benefit of Section 28(e), the Adviser must make a good faith determination that the commissions paid are “reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage and research services provided by such member, broker, or dealer, viewed in terms of either that particular transaction or his overall responsibilities with respect to the accounts as to which he exercises investment discretion.” Accordingly, the price to a Funds in any transaction may be less favorable than that available from another broker/dealer if the difference is reasonably justified by other aspects of the portfolio execution services offered. Some broker/dealers may indicate that the provision of research services is dependent upon the generation of certain specified levels of commissions and underwriting concessions by the Adviser’s clients, including the Funds.

Commission rates are established pursuant to negotiations with broker/dealers based on the quality and quantity of execution services provided by broker/dealers in light of generally prevailing rates. On exchanges on which commissions are negotiated, the cost of transactions may vary among different broker/dealers. Transactions on foreign stock exchanges involve payment of brokerage commissions that generally are fixed. Transactions in both foreign and domestic over-the-counter markets generally are principal transactions with dealers, and the costs of such transactions involve dealer spreads rather than brokerage commissions. With respect to over-the-counter transactions, the Adviser, where possible, will deal directly with dealers who make a market in the securities involved, except in those circumstances in which better prices and execution are available elsewhere.

In certain instances there may be securities that are suitable for a Fund as well as for one or more of the other clients of the Adviser. Investment decisions for the Funds and for the Adviser’s other clients are made with the goal of achieving their respective investment objectives. A particular security may be bought or sold for only one client even though it may be held by, or bought or sold for, other clients. Likewise, a particular security may be bought for one or more clients when one or more other clients are selling that same security. Some simultaneous transactions are inevitable when a number of accounts receive investment advice from the same investment adviser, particularly when the same security is suitable for the investment objectives of more than one client. When two or more clients are engaged simultaneously in the purchase or sale of the same security, the securities are allocated among clients in a manner believed to be equitable to each. In some cases, this policy could have a detrimental effect on the price or volume of the security in a particular transaction that may affect the Funds.

The Funds may participate, if and when practicable, in bidding for the purchase of portfolio securities directly from an issuer in order to take advantage of the lower purchase price available to members of a bidding group. A Fund will engage in this practice, however, only when the Adviser, in its sole discretion, believes such practice to be otherwise in such Fund’s interests.

The Trust will not execute portfolio transactions through, or buy or sell portfolio securities from or to, the Distributor, the Adviser, the Administrator or their affiliates acting as principal (including repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements), except to the extent permitted by applicable law, regulation or order. However, the Adviser is authorized to allocate buy and sell orders for portfolio securities to certain broker/dealers and financial institutions, including, in the case of agency transactions, broker/dealers and financial institutions that are affiliated with Ameriprise Financial. To the extent that a Fund executes any securities trades with an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial, such Fund does so in conformity with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act and the procedures that such Fund has adopted pursuant to the rule. In this regard, for each transaction, the Board will determine

 

150


Table of Contents

that: (i) the transaction resulted in prices for and execution of securities transactions at least as favorable to the particular Fund as those likely to be derived from a non-affiliated qualified broker/dealer; (ii) the affiliated broker/dealer charged the Fund commission rates consistent with those charged by the affiliated broker/dealer in similar transactions to clients comparable to the Fund and that are not affiliated with the broker/dealer in question; and (iii) the fees, commissions or other remuneration paid by the Fund did not exceed 2% of the sales price of the securities if the sale was effected in connection with a secondary distribution, or 1% of the purchase or sale price of such securities if effected in other than a secondary distribution.

Certain affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may have deposit, loan or commercial banking relationships with the corporate users of facilities financed by industrial development revenue bonds or private activity bonds bought by certain of the Columbia Funds. Ameriprise Financial or certain of its affiliates may serve as trustee, custodian, tender agent, guarantor, placement agent, underwriter, or in some other capacity, with respect to certain issues of securities. Under certain circumstances, a Fund may buy securities from a member of an underwriting syndicate in which an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial is a member. The Trust has adopted procedures pursuant to Rule 10f-3 under the 1940 Act, and intends to comply with the requirements of Rule 10f-3, in connection with any purchases of municipal securities that may be subject to Rule 10f-3.

Given the breadth of the Adviser’s investment management activities, investment decisions for the Funds are not always made independently from those for other funds, or other investment companies and accounts advised or managed by the Adviser. When a purchase or sale of the same security is made at substantially the same time on behalf of one or more of the Columbia Funds and another investment portfolio, investment company or account, the transaction will be averaged as to price and available investments allocated as to amount in a manner which the Adviser believes to be equitable to the Funds and such other funds, investment portfolio, investment company or account. In some instances, this investment procedure may adversely affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the position obtained or sold by the Fund. To the extent permitted by law, the Adviser may aggregate the securities to be sold or bought for the Funds with those to be sold or bought for other funds, investment portfolios, investment companies, or accounts in executing transactions.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about these and other conflicts of interest.

Brokerage Commissions

The following charts reflect the amounts of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recently completed fiscal periods/years. In certain instances, the Funds may pay brokerage commissions to broker/dealers that are affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. As indicated above, all such transactions involving the payment of brokerage commissions to affiliates are done in compliance with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act.

Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds

The following charts reflect the aggregate amount of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recently completed fiscal periods/years. Differences, year to year, in the amount of brokerage commissions paid by a Fund were primarily the result of increased market volatility as well as shareholder purchase and redemption activity in the Fund.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Convertible Securities Fund

   $ 78,360       $ 322,359       $ 284,499   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   $ 252,593       $ 1,214,329       $ 903,415   

Large Cap Index Fund

   $ 79,256       $ 57,287       $ 36,653   

Large Cap Value Fund

   $ 3,143,773       $ 3,621,587       $ 3,846,915   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $ 14,472,692       $ 18,909,158       $ 17,682,363   

 

151


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
    Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
    Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $ 6,634,701      $ 5,535,587      $ 3,076,353   

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $ 4,607,371      $ 2,963,749      $ 2,042,309   

Global Value Fund

   $ 43,086      $ 97,403.51      $ 336,900   

Marsico Global Fund1

   $ 19,741      $ 15,550        N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $ 4,199,116      $ 7,094,625      $ 8,847,436   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   $ 126,059      $ 131,394      $ 146,945   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $ 2,712,557   $ 3,912,632 **    $ 4,860,579 *** 

Overseas Value Fund2

   $ 16,847      $ 28,497        N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

   $ 123,678      $ 188,373      $ 172,836   

 

* This amount includes $220,976 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that was subadvised by Causeway and $2,491,581 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that is subadvised by Marsico.
** This amount includes $829,079 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that was subadvised by Causeway and $3,083,553 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that is sub-advised by Marsico.
***

This amount includes $1,112, 239 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that was subadvised by Causeway and $3,748,340 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that is sub-advised by Marsico.

1

Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no brokerage commissions prior to that date.

2

Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no brokerage commissions prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007
 

International Value Fund*

   $ 962,909       $ 1,020,816       $ 3,079,182       $ 3,022,497   

Large Cap Core Fund

   $ 3,517,838       $ 3,504,058       $ 2,410,933       $ 3,338,986   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $ 6,633,291       $ 7,461,288       $ 7,365,073       $ 3,408,940   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $ 8,957,276       $ 11,114,481       $ 5,108,886       $ 3,906,181   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 1,469,836       $ 1,413,250       $ 2,688,711       $ 2,144,191   

 

* Because the Feeder Fund’s brokerage commissions are paid at the Master Portfolio level, amounts shown are for the Fund’s Master Portfolio.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $ 21,870       $ 41,585       $ 28,943   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,099         —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   $ 961       $ 12,273       $ 1,862   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 472         —     

High Income Fund

   $ 3,715       $ 36,672       $ 75,531   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   $ 8,650         —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   $ 5,730         —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   $ 2,180         —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     —           —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 875         —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     —           —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,619         —     

Short Term Bond Fund

   $ 34,869       $ 10,309       $ 8,123   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,486         —     

Total Return Bond Fund

   $ 85,184       $ 89,362       $ 57,337   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,261         —     

 

152


Table of Contents

 

Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds to Certain Broker/Dealers

The Funds paid brokerage commissions to certain broker/dealers for the three most recently completed fiscal periods/years, as indicated in the following table:

 

         Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid  

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Global Value Fund

   BAS     —         $ 2,907       $ 3,722   
   MLPF&S   $ 2,509         —           N/A   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   Banc of America
Securities LLC

(BAS)

    —           —           —     
   Merrill Lynch,
Pierce, Fenner &
Smith
Incorporated

(MLPF&S)

  $ 413,221       $ 12,001         N/A   

Marsico Global Value Fund

   BAS     —           —           N/A   
   MLPF&S   $ 839         —           N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   BAS     —           —           N/A   
   MLPF&S   $ 184,099       $ 24,106         N/A   

Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund (Causeway**

and Marsico)

   BAS     —           —           N/A   

Causeway**

   MLPF&S   $ 33,848       $ 11,737         N/A   

Marsico

   MLPF&S   $ 106,469       $ 13,484         N/A   

 

          Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid  

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*    Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007
 

International Value Fund

   BAS      —           —         $ 5,021         N/A   
   MLPF&S    $ 12,546       $ 40,508         N/A         N/A   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   BAS      —           —           —           —     
   MLPF&S    $ 70,447       $ 713         N/A         N/A   

Marsico Growth Fund

   BAS      —           —           —           —     
   MLPF&S    $ 148,003       $ 16,336         N/A         N/A   

 

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*      Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Brokerage Commissions Paid to the
Certain Broker/Dealers During the
Most Recent Fiscal Year
    Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Dollar Amount of Transactions
Involving the Payment of
Commissions Effected Through the
Broker/Dealer During the Most
Recent Fiscal Year
 

Marsico 21st Century Fund

     MLPF&S         2.86     2.68

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

     MLPF&S         1.06     1.97

 

153


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*      Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Brokerage Commissions Paid to the
Certain Broker/Dealers During the
Most Recent Fiscal Year
    Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Dollar Amount of Transactions
Involving the Payment of
Commissions Effected Through the
Broker/Dealer During the Most
Recent Fiscal Year
 

Marsico Growth Fund

     MLPF&S         1.65     2.42

Global Value Fund

     MLPF&S         1.5     5.8

Marsico Global Value Fund

     MLPF&S         4.25     3.59

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

     MLPF&S         4.38     5.55

Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

       

Causeway**

     MLPF&S         15     28

Marsico

     MLPF&S         4.27     5.37

International Value Fund

     MLPF&S         1.3     1.3

 

* Prior to May 1, 2010, BAS and MLPF&S (as of January 1, 2009) and other broker-dealers affiliated with BANA were affiliated broker/dealers of the Fund by virtue of being under common control with the Previous Adviser. The affiliation created by this relationship ended on May 1, 2010, when the investment advisory agreement with the Previous Adviser was terminated and the Fund entered into a new investment management services agreement with the Adviser. However, BANA, on behalf of its fiduciary accounts, continues to have investments in certain of the Columbia Funds. The amounts shown include any brokerage commissions paid to BAS and MLPF&S after May 1, 2010.
** Causeway served as co-investment subadviser to approximately half of the assets of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund until July 8, 2009. At that time, the Previous Adviser assumed primary investment management responsibility for that portion of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund previously subadvised by Causeway.

Directed Brokerage

The Funds or the Adviser, through an agreement or understanding with a broker/dealer, or otherwise through an internal allocation procedure, may direct, subject to applicable legal requirements, the Funds’ brokerage transactions to a broker/dealer because of the research services it provides the Funds or the Adviser.

During each Fund’s last fiscal year, the Funds directed certain brokerage transactions and paid related commissions in the amounts as follows:

 

Fund

   Amount of Transactions      Related Commissions  

For Funds with fiscal year ended February 28, 2010

     

Convertible Securities Fund

   $ 84,141,442       $ 19,218   

Global Value Fund

     —           —     

International Value Fund

     —           —     

Large Cap Core Fund

   $ 3,437,201,420       $ 597,376   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

     —           —     

Large Cap Index Fund

     —           —     

Large Cap Value Fund

   $ 2,852,218,744       $ 356,068   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $ 1,653,516,816       $ 2,716,976   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $ 874,643,755       $ 1,240,638   

Marsico Global Fund

   $ 2,641,551       $ 4,576   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $ 1,072,612,866       $ 1,670,277   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $ 1,148,257,498       $ 2,071,350   

Mid Cap Index Fund

     —           —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $ 4,260,260,243       $ 407,393   

 

154


Table of Contents

Fund

   Amount of Transactions      Related Commissions  

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $ 730,003,570       $ 1,447,999   

Overseas Value Fund

   $ 8,723,978       $ 2,053   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 680,363,344       $ 64,147   

Small Cap Index Fund

     —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $ 1,661,955,281       $ 199,929   

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

     

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $ 764,628       $ 604   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     —           —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

High Income Fund

   $ 81,665       $ 464   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

     —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

     —           —     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Total Return Bond Fund

     —           —     

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

In certain cases, the Funds, as part of their principal investment strategies, or otherwise as a permissible investment, will invest in the common stock or debt obligations of the regular broker/dealers that the Adviser uses to transact brokerage for the Funds.

As of each Fund’s fiscal year end, the Funds owned securities of their “regular brokers or dealers” or their parents, as defined in Rule 10b-1 under the 1940 Act, as shown in the table below:

Investments in Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

 

Fund

   Broker/Dealer      Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended February 28, 2010

     

Convertible Securities Fund

     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 4,440,770   
     Goldman Sachs & Co.       $ 9,896,282   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 10,683,096   
     Deutsche Bank AG       $ 18,036,980   

Global Value Fund

     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 790,054   

International Value Fund

     None       $ 0   

 

155


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer    Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

Large Cap Core Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 4,523,454   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 35,273,686   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 27,955,380   
   State Street Corp.    $ 2,792,055   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 5,206,455   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 7,470,660   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 284,618   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 4,344,860   

Large Cap Index Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 21,179,640   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 10,092,695   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 43,572,205   
   State Street Corp.    $ 5,854,872   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 17,466,643   
   Bank of New York Mellon Corp.    $ 9,049,225   

Large Cap Value Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 71,514,490   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 37,947,188   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 88,368,255   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 24,164,391   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 209,491,338   
   State Street Corp.    $ 76,167,719   
   Jefferies Group, Inc.    $ 102,963,894   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 112,953,650   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 101,678,956   

Marsico Global Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 262,858   

Marsico Growth Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 136,367,376   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 119,551,041   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 36,296,625   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   Jefferies Group, Inc.    $ 6,256,224   

Mid Cap Value Fund

   None    $ 0   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 11,847,972   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 22,572,834   

Overseas Value Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 144,656   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   None    $ 0   

Small Cap Index Fund

   None    $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund II

   None    $ 0   

 

156


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer      Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

     

Asset Allocation Fund II

     Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.       $ 714,439   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 3,467,919   
     Goldman Sachs & Co.       $ 644,830   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 710,140   
     Barclays Capital       $ 193,601   
     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 418,309   
     Wachovia Corp.       $ 646,632   
     UBS Warburg LLC       $ 326,481   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     Barclays Capital       $ 138,762   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 86,304   
     Wells Fargo & Co.       $ 135,807   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

High Income Fund

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 151,287   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 653,143   
     Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.       $ 1,294,949   
     Wells Fargo & Co.       $ 1,921,226   
     UBS Warburg LLC       $ 1,383,094   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 421,470   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

Short Term Bond Fund

     Barclays Capital       $ 15,359,481   
     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 78,017,877   
     Goldman Sachs & Co.       $ 18,335,446   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 62,171,265   
     Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.       $ 10,283,062   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 17,660,333   
     Wells Fargo & Co.       $ 17,312,165   
     UBS Warburg LLC       $ 28,990,178   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

 

157


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer    Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

Total Return Bond Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 3,555,138   
   Wells Fargo & Co.    $ 51,378,326   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 20,592,570   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 40,962,258   
   UBS Warburg LLC    $ 20,553,415   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 13,233,784   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 22,018,435   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 15,153,171   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   None    $ 0   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

The Funds, along with the Transfer Agent and/or the Distributor and the Adviser, may pay significant amounts to financial intermediaries (as defined below), including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for providing the types of services that would typically be provided directly by a mutual fund’s transfer agent. The level of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. A number of factors may be considered in determining payments to a financial intermediary, including, without limitation, the nature of the services provided to shareholders or retirement plan participants that invest in the Funds through retirement plans. These services may include sub-accounting, sub-transfer agency or similar recordkeeping services, shareholder or participant reporting, shareholder or participant transaction processing, and/or the provision of call center support (additional shareholder services). These payments for shareholder servicing support with respect to the Columbia Funds vary by financial intermediary but generally are not expected, with certain limited exceptions, to exceed 0.40% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan, and 0.45% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that do not pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan. The Board has authorized each Fund to pay up to 0.15% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares. Such payments will be made by a Fund to the Transfer Agent who will in turn make payments to the financial intermediary for the provision of such additional shareholder services. The Funds’ Transfer Agent, Distributor or their affiliates will pay, from its or their own resources, amounts in excess of the amount paid by the Funds to financial intermediaries in connection with the provision of these additional shareholder services and other services.

For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment advisor, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Funds also may make additional payments to financial intermediaries that charge networking fees for certain services provided in connection with the maintenance of shareholder accounts through the NSCC.

In addition, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may make lump sum payments to selected financial intermediaries receiving shareholder servicing payments in reimbursement of printing costs for literature for participants, account maintenance fees or fees for establishment of the Funds on the financial intermediary’s system or other similar services.

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates had agreed to make shareholder servicing payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

 

158


Table of Contents

 

Recipients of Shareholder Servicing Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

Acclaim Benefits, Inc.

   

A.G. Edwards

   

Alerus Retirement Solutions

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Benefit Plan Administrators

   

Bisys Retirement Services

   

Charles Schwab & Co.

   

Charles Schwab Trust Co.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

CitiStreet LLC

   

City National Bank

   

Compensation & Capital Administrative Services, Inc.

   

CPI Qualified Plan Consultants

   

Daily Access Concepts, Inc.

   

Digital Retirement Solutions

   

Dreyfus

   

Edward D. Jones & Co., L.P.

   

E*Trade Group, Inc.

   

ExpertPlan

   

Fidelity Investments Institutional Operations Co.

   

First Clearing LLC

   

Genworth Financial

   

GPC Securities, Inc.

   

Guardian Life Insurance Company

   

GWFS Equities, Inc.

   

Hartford Life Insurance Company

   

Hewitt Associates LLC

   

ICMA Retirement Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Company

   

ING Institutional Plan Services, LLP

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company (USA)

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company of New York

   

JP Morgan Retirement Plan Services LLC

   

Lincoln Financial Group

   

LPL Financial Corporation

   

Marshall & Illsley Trust Company

   

Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company

   

Matrix Settlement & Clearance Services

   

Mercer HR Services, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Mid Atlantic Capital Corporation

   

Morgan Keegan & Co., Inc.

   

Morgan Stanley & Co., Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Investor Services Corp.

   

Newport Retirement Services, Inc.

   

New York State Deferred Compensation Plan

   

NYLife Distributors LLC

   

PNC Advisors

   

Princeton Retirement Group

   

Principal Life Insurance Company

   

Prudential Insurance Company of America

   

Prudential Retirement Insurance & Annuity Co.

   

Reliance Trust Company

   

Robert W. Baird & Co., Inc.

   

Royal Alliance Associates, Inc.

   

Standard Retirement Services, Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Clearing Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Trust Company

   

Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association of America

   

The 401k Company

   

T. Rowe Price Group, Inc.

   

The Vanguard Group, Inc.

   

Unified Trust Company, N.A.

   

UPromise Investments, Inc.

   

VALIC Retirement Services

   

Wachovia Bank, N.A.

   

Wachovia Securities, LLC

   

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management, LLC

   

Wilmington Trust Corporation

   

Wilmington Trust Retirement & Institutional Services Company


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

 

159


Table of Contents

 

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

Financial intermediaries may receive different commissions, sales charge reallowances and other payments with respect to sales of different classes of shares of the Funds. These other payments may include servicing payments to retirement plan administrators and other institutions at rates up to those described above under Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices — Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment adviser, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may pay additional compensation to selected financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, under the categories described below. These categories are not mutually exclusive, and a single financial intermediary may receive payments under all categories. A financial intermediary also may receive payments described above in Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices — Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. These payments may create an incentive for a financial intermediary or its representatives to recommend or offer shares of a Fund to its customers. The amount of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. In determining the amount of payments to be made, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may consider a number of factors, including, without limitation, asset mix and length of relationship with the financial intermediary, the size of the customer/shareholder base of the financial intermediary, the manner in which customers of the financial intermediary make investments in the Funds, the nature and scope of marketing support or services provided by the financial intermediary (as described more fully below) and the costs incurred by the financial intermediary in connection with maintaining the infrastructure necessary or desirable to support investments in the Funds.

These additional payments by the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates are made pursuant to agreements between the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates and financial intermediaries, and do not change the price paid by investors for the purchase of a share, the amount a Fund will receive as proceeds from such sales or the distribution fees and expenses paid by the Fund as shown under the heading Fees and Expenses of the Fund/Portfolio in the Fund’s prospectuses.

Marketing Support Payments

The Distributor and the Adviser may make payments, from their own resources, to certain financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for marketing support services relating to the Columbia Funds, including, but not limited to, business planning assistance, educating financial intermediary personnel about the Funds and shareholder financial planning needs, placement on the financial intermediary’s preferred or recommended fund list or otherwise identifying the Funds as being part of a complex to be accorded a higher degree of marketing support than complexes not making such payments, access to sales meetings, sales representatives and management representatives of the financial intermediary, client servicing and systems infrastructure support. These payments are generally based upon one or more of the following factors: average net assets of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, gross sales of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, reimbursement of ticket charges (fees that a financial intermediary firm charges its representatives for effecting transactions in fund shares) or a negotiated lump sum payment.

While the financial arrangements may vary for each financial intermediary, the marketing support payments to each financial intermediary generally are expected to be between 0.05% and 0.50% on an annual basis for payments based on average net assets of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary, and between 0.05% and 0.25% on an annual basis for firms receiving a payment based on gross sales of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary. The Distributor and affiliates may make payments in materially larger amounts or on a basis materially different from those described above when dealing with certain financial intermediaries. Such increased payments may enable the financial intermediaries to offset credits that they may provide to their customers.

 

160


Table of Contents

 

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or the Adviser had agreed to make marketing support payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

Recipients of Marketing Support Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

AIG Advisor Group

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

AXA Advisors, LLC

   

Banc of America Investment Services, Inc.

   

Banc of America Securities LLC

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Bank of New York

   

Citibank, N.A.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

Commonwealth Financial Network

   

Custodial Trust Company

   

Fidelity Brokerage Services, Inc.

   

Genworth Financial, Inc.

   

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

   

GunAllen Financial, Inc.

   

Harris Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Co.

   

J.J.B. Hilliard, W.L. Lyons, Inc.

   

J.P. Morgan Clearing Corp.

   

Liberty Life Insurance Co.

   

Lincoln Financial Advisors Corp.

   

Linsco/Private Ledger Corp.

   

Mellon Financial Markets, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Financial Services LLC

   

Pershing LLC

   

Prudential Investment Management Services, LLC

   

Raymond James & Associates, Inc.

   

Raymond James Financial Services, Inc.

   

SEI Investments Inc.

   

State Street Global Markets, LLC

   

Transamerica Corporation

   

UBS Financial Services Inc.

   

US Bank National Association

   

Wachovia Securities LLC

   

Webster Investment Services, Inc.

   

Wells Fargo Corporate Trust Services

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management LLC

   

Wells Fargo Investments, LLC


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or the Adviser may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

Other Payments

From time to time, the Distributor, from its own resources, may provide additional compensation to certain financial intermediaries that sell or arrange for the sale of shares of the Funds to the extent not prohibited by laws or the rules of any self-regulatory agency, such as the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA). Such compensation provided by the Distributor may include financial assistance to financial intermediaries that enable the Distributor to participate in and/or present at financial intermediary-sponsored conferences or seminars, sales or training programs for invited registered representatives and other financial intermediary employees, financial intermediary entertainment and other financial intermediary-sponsored events, and travel expenses, including lodging incurred by registered representatives and other employees in connection with prospecting, retention and due diligence trips. The Distributor makes payments for entertainment events it deems appropriate, subject to the Distributor’s internal guidelines and applicable law. These payments may vary depending upon the nature of the event.

Your financial intermediary may charge you fees or commissions in addition to those disclosed in this SAI. You should consult with your financial intermediary and review carefully any disclosure your financial intermediary provides regarding its services and compensation. Depending on the financial arrangement in place

 

161


Table of Contents

at any particular time, a financial intermediary and its financial consultants may have a financial incentive for recommending a particular fund or a particular share class over other funds or share classes. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information.

 

162


Table of Contents

 

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

Description of the Trust’s Shares

The Funds offer shares in the classes shown in the table below. Subject to certain limited exceptions discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses, a Fund may no longer be accepting new investments from current shareholders or prospective investors. Class B shares of the Funds are closed to new investments, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares. Additional Class B shares of the Funds will be issued only in connection with (i) reinvestment of dividends and/or capital gain distributions in Class B shares of each Fund by the Fund’s existing Class B shareholders and (ii) exchanges by shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Columbia Fund may exchange those shares for Class B shares of a Fund. The Funds, however, may at any time and without notice, offer any of these classes to the general public for investment.

The Trust’s Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust (Declaration of Trust) permits it to issue an unlimited number of full and fractional shares of beneficial interest of each Fund, without par value, and to divide or combine the shares of any series into a greater or lesser number of shares of that Fund without thereby changing the proportionate beneficial interests in that Fund and to divide such shares into classes. Each share of a class of a Fund represents an equal proportional interest in that Fund with each other share in the same class and is entitled to such distributions out of the income earned on the assets belonging to that Fund as are declared in the discretion of the Board. However, different share classes of a Fund pay different distribution amounts because each share class has different expenses. Each time a distribution is made, the net asset value per share of the share class is reduced by the amount of the distribution.

Share Classes Offered by the Funds

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares1
     Class C
Shares
     Class I
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class R4
Shares
     Shares      Class W
Shares
     Class  Y
Shares3
     Class Z
Shares
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

Convertible Securities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü                        ü     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

                     ü              

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

Global Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

High Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

International Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü                     ü     

Large Cap Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü                  ü            ü     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   ü               ü         ü                  ü         ü     

Large Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü                              ü     

Large Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü               ü         ü         ü     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                     ü     

 

163


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares1
     Class C
Shares
     Class I
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class R4
Shares
    Shares      Class W
Shares
     Class  Y
Shares3
     Class Z
Shares
 

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü                       ü     

Marsico Global Fund

   ü            ü            ü                    ü     

Marsico Growth Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü              ü            ü     

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü                    ü     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

Mid Cap Index Fund

   ü               ü                       ü     

Mid Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü  2         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

                    ü              

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü  2         ü            ü     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Overseas Value Fund

   ü            ü            ü                    ü     

Short Term Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü  2         ü         ü         ü     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Small Cap Index Fund

   ü                                ü     

Small Cap Value Fund II

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü                    ü     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

 

164


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares1
     Class C
Shares
     Class I
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class R4
Shares
     Shares      Class W
Shares
     Class  Y
Shares3
     Class Z
Shares
 

Total Return Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

 

1

Class B shares of the Funds are closed to new investments, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares. Additional Class B shares of the Funds will be issued only in connection with (i) reinvestment of dividends and/or capital gain distributions in Class B shares of each Fund by the Fund’s existing Class B shareholders and (ii) exchanges by shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Columbia Fund may exchange those shares for Class B shares of a Fund. See the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds for details.

2

Class R4 shares of Mid Cap Value Fund, Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund and Short Term Bond Fund have not commenced operations as of the date of this SAI.

3

The Funds also offers Class Y shares, which are included in a different statement of additional information.

Restrictions on Holding or Disposing of Shares

There are no restrictions on the right of shareholders to retain or dispose of the Funds’ shares, other than the possible future termination of the Funds. The Funds may be terminated by reorganization into another mutual fund or by liquidation and distribution of their assets. Unless terminated by reorganization or liquidation, the Funds will continue indefinitely.

Shareholder Liability

The Trust is organized under Delaware law, which provides that shareholders of a statutory trust are entitled to the same limitations of personal liability as shareholders of a corporation organized under Delaware law. Effectively, this means that a shareholder of the Funds will not be personally liable for payment of the Funds’ debts except by reason of his or her own conduct or acts. In addition, a shareholder could incur a financial loss on account of the Funds’ obligation only if the Funds had no remaining assets with which to meet such obligation. We believe that the possibility of such a situation arising is extremely remote.

Dividend Rights

The shareholders of a Fund are entitled to receive any dividends or other distributions declared for the Fund. No shares have priority or preference over any other shares of the Funds with respect to distributions. Distributions will be made from the assets of the Funds, and will be paid pro rata to all shareholders of each Fund (or class) according to the number of shares of each Fund (or class) held by shareholders on the record date. The amount of income dividends per share may vary between separate share classes of the Funds based upon differences in the way that expenses are allocated between share classes pursuant to a multiple class plan.

Voting Rights and Shareholder Meetings

Shareholders have the power to vote only as expressly granted under the 1940 Act or under Delaware statutory trust law. Shareholders have no independent right to vote on any matter, including the creation, operation, dissolution or termination of the Trust. Shareholders have the right to vote on other matters only as the Board authorizes. Currently, the 1940 Act requires that shareholders have the right to vote, under certain circumstances, to: (i) elect Trustees; (ii) approve investment advisory agreements and principal underwriting agreements; (iii) approve a change in subclassification of a Fund; (iv) approve any change in fundamental investment policies; (v) approve a distribution plan under Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act; and (vi) to terminate the independent accountant. With respect to matters that affect one class but not another, shareholders vote as a

 

165


Table of Contents

class; for example, the approval of a distribution plan applicable to that class. Subject to the foregoing, all shares of the Trust have equal voting rights and will be voted in the aggregate, and not by Fund, except where voting by Fund is required by law or where the matter involved only affects one Fund. For example, a change in a Fund’s fundamental investment policy affects only one Fund and would be voted upon only by shareholders of the Fund involved. Additionally, approval of an investment advisory agreement or investment subadvisory agreement, since it only affects one Fund, is a matter to be determined separately by each Fund. Approval by the shareholders of one Fund is effective as to that Fund whether or not sufficient votes are received from the shareholders of the other series to approve the proposal as to those Funds. Shareholders are entitled to one vote for each whole share held and a proportional fractional vote for each fractional vote held, on matters on which they are entitled to vote. Fund shareholders do not have cumulative voting rights. The Trust is not required to hold, and has no present intention of holding, annual meetings of shareholders.

Liquidation Rights

In the event of the liquidation or dissolution of the Trust or the Funds, shareholders of the Funds are entitled to receive the assets attributable to the relevant class of shares of the Funds that are available for distribution and to a distribution of any general assets not attributable to a particular investment portfolio that are available for distribution in such manner and on such basis as the Board may determine.

Preemptive Rights

There are no preemptive rights associated with Fund shares.

Conversion Rights

With the exception of Class B shares, which no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares as described in the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds, shareholders have the right, which is subject to change by the Board, to convert or “exchange” shares of one class for another. Such right is outlined and subject to certain conditions set forth in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Redemptions

Each Fund’s dividend, distribution and redemption policies can be found in its prospectuses under the headings Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares and Distributions and Taxes. However, the Board may suspend the right of shareholders to sell shares when permitted or required to do so by law or compel sales of shares in certain cases.

Sinking Fund Provisions

The Trust has no sinking fund provisions.

Calls or Assessment

All Fund shares are issued in uncertificated form only and when issued will be fully paid and non-assessable by the Trust.

 

166


Table of Contents

 

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

Purchase and Redemption

An investor may buy, sell and exchange shares in the Funds utilizing the methods, and subject to the restrictions, described in the Funds’ prospectuses. The following information supplements information in the Funds’ prospectuses.

The Funds have authorized one or more broker/dealers to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. These broker/dealers are authorized to designate other intermediaries to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. The Funds will be deemed to have received a buy or sell order when an authorized broker/dealer, or, if applicable, a broker/dealer’s authorized designee, accepts the order. Customer orders will be priced at each Fund’s net asset value next computed after they are accepted by an authorized broker/dealer or the broker’s authorized designee.

The Trust also may make payment for sales in readily marketable securities or other property if it is appropriate to do so in light of the Trust’s responsibilities under the 1940 Act.

Under the 1940 Act, the Funds may suspend the right of redemption or postpone the date of payment for shares during any period when (i) trading on the NYSE is restricted by applicable rules and regulations of the SEC; (ii) the NYSE is closed for other than customary weekend and holiday closings; (iii) the SEC has by order permitted such suspension; (iv) an emergency exists as determined by the SEC. (The Funds may also suspend or postpone the recordation of the transfer of their shares upon the occurrence of any of the foregoing conditions).

The Trust has elected to be governed by Rule 18f-1 under the 1940 Act, as a result of which each Fund is obligated to redeem shares, subject to the exceptions listed above, with respect to any one shareholder during any 90-day period, solely in cash up to the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the net asset value of each Fund at the beginning of the period.

Tax-Advantaged Retirement Plans (Retirement Plans)

The Transfer Agent maintains prototype tax-qualified plans, including Pension and Profit-Sharing Plans, for individuals, corporations, employees and the self-employed. The minimum initial Retirement Plan investment is $1,000, applied at the plan level. BANA is the custodian/trustee and plan sponsor of the Columbia Management prototype plans offered through the Distributor. In general a $20 annual fee is charged.

Participants in Retirement Plans not sponsored by BANA, not including IRAs, may be subject to an annual fee of $20 unless the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account with the Transfer Agent. Participants in BANA sponsored prototype plans (other than IRAs) who liquidate the total value of their account may also be charged a $20 close-out processing fee payable to the Transfer Agent. The close-out fee applies to plans opened after September 1, 1996. The fee is in addition to any applicable CDSC. The fee will not apply if the participant uses the proceeds to open a Columbia Management IRA Rollover account in any fund distributed by the Distributor, or if the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account.

Consultation with a competent financial advisor regarding these Retirement Plans and consideration of the suitability of fund shares as an investment under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or otherwise is recommended.

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

167


Table of Contents

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R shares and Class R4 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R shares and Class R4 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

 

168


Table of Contents

 

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.
** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

169


Table of Contents

 

Anti-Money Laundering Compliance

The Funds are required to comply with various anti-money laundering laws and regulations. Consequently, the Funds may request additional required information from you to verify your identity. Your application will be rejected if it does not contain your name, social security number, date of birth and permanent street address. If at any time the Funds believe a shareholder may be involved in suspicious activity or if certain account information matches information on government lists of suspicious persons, the Funds may choose not to establish a new account or may be required to “freeze” a shareholder’s account. The Funds also may be required to provide a governmental agency with information about transactions that have occurred in a shareholder’s account or to transfer monies received to establish a new account, transfer an existing account or transfer the proceeds of an existing account to a governmental agency. In some circumstances, the law may not permit the Funds to inform the shareholder that it has taken the actions described above.

Offering Price

The share price of each Fund is based on each Fund’s net asset value per share, which is calculated separately for each class of shares as of the close of regular trading on the NYSE (which is usually 4:00 p.m. Eastern time unless the NYSE closes earlier) on each day the Funds are open for business, unless the Board determines otherwise.

The value of each Fund’s portfolio securities for which a market quotation is available is determined in accordance with the Trust’s valuation procedures. In general terms, the valuation procedures provide that domestic exchange traded securities (other than NASDAQ listed equity securities) generally will be valued at their last traded sale prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. If no sales of those securities are reported on a particular day on the principal exchange, the securities generally will be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. Securities traded on a foreign securities exchange will generally be valued at their last sale prices on the exchange where the securities are primarily traded, or in the absence of a reported sale on a particular day, at their bid prices (in the case of securities held long) or ask prices (in the case of securities held short) as reported by that exchange. Securities traded primarily on NASDAQ will generally be valued at the NASDAQ Official Closing Price (NOCP) (which is the last trade price at or before 4:00:02 p.m. (Eastern Time) adjusted up to NASDAQ’s best bid price if the last trade price is below such bid price or adjusted down to NASDAQ’s best ask price if the last trade price is above such ask price). If no NOCP is available, the security will generally be valued at the last sale price shown on NASDAQ prior to the calculation of the NAV of the Fund. If no sale price is shown on NASDAQ, the latest bid price will be used. If no sale price is shown and no latest bid price is available, the price will be deemed “stale” and the value will be determined in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

Securities not traded upon any exchange will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices based upon quotes furnished by the appropriate market makers. If quoted prices are unavailable or are believed to be inaccurate, market values will generally be determined based on quotes obtained from one or more broker(s) or dealer(s) or based on a price obtained from a reputable independent pricing service.

Financial futures will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price. Forward foreign currency contracts will generally be valued using market quotations from a widely used quotation system that reflects the current cost of covering or off-setting the contract. Exchange traded options will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price on their exchange. If there is no reported sale on the valuation date, the options will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices.

Over-the-counter derivatives will generally be valued at fair value in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

 

170


Table of Contents

 

Repurchase agreements will generally be valued at a price equal to the amount of the cash invested in the repurchase agreement at the time of valuation. The market value of the securities underlying a repurchase agreement will be determined in accordance with the procedures above, as appropriate, for the purpose of determining the adequacy of collateral.

Shares of open-end investment companies held in each Fund’s portfolio will generally be valued at the latest net asset value reported by the investment company.

Debt securities will generally be valued by a pricing service which may employ a matrix or other indications of value, including but not limited to broker quotes, to determine valuations for normal institutional size trading units. The matrix can take into account various factors including, without limitation, bids, yield spreads, and/or other market data and specific security characteristics (e.g., credit quality, maturity and coupon rate). Debt securities for which a pricing service does not furnish valuations and for which market quotations are readily available will generally be valued based on the mean of the latest bid prices obtained from one or more dealers. Debt securities with remaining maturities of 60 days or less will, absent unusual circumstances, be valued at amortized cost.

Securities for which market quotations are not readily available for any reason, including that the latest quotation is deemed unreliable or unreasonable, securities and other assets and liabilities are valued at “fair value” as determined in good faith by the Adviser’s valuation committee. In general, any one or more of the following factors may be taken into account in determining fair value: the fundamental analytical data relating to the security; the value of other financial instruments, including derivative securities, traded on other markets or among dealers; trading volumes on markets, exchanges, or among dealers; values of baskets of securities traded on other markets; changes in interest rates; observations from financial institutions; government (domestic or foreign) actions or pronouncements; other news events; information as to any transactions or offers with respect to the security; price and extent of public trading in similar securities of the issuer or comparable companies; nature and expected duration of the event, if any, giving rise to the valuation issue; pricing history of the security; the relative size of the position in the portfolio; and other relevant information.

With respect to securities traded on foreign markets, the following factors also may be relevant: the value of foreign securities traded on other foreign markets; ADR trading; closed-end fund trading; foreign currency exchange activity; and the trading of financial products that are tied to baskets of foreign securities, such as World Equity Benchmark Shares™.

The Board has determined, and the valuation procedures provide, that in certain circumstances it may be necessary to use an alternative valuation method, such as in-kind redemptions with affiliated benefit plans where the Department of Labor requires that valuation to be done in accordance with Rule 17a-7 of the 1940 Act.

 

171


Table of Contents

 

TAXATION

The following information supplements and should be read in conjunction with the section in the Funds’ prospectuses entitled “Distributions and Taxes.” The prospectuses generally describe the U.S. federal income tax treatment of distributions by the Funds. This section of the SAI provides additional information concerning U.S. federal income taxes. It is based on the Code, applicable Treasury Regulations, judicial authority, and administrative rulings and practice, all as in effect as of the date of this SAI and all of which are subject to change, including changes with retroactive effect. Except as specifically set forth below, the following discussion does not address any state, local or foreign tax matters.

A shareholder’s tax treatment may vary depending upon his or her particular situation. This discussion applies only to shareholders holding Fund shares as capital assets within the meaning of the Code. Except as otherwise noted, it may not apply to certain types of shareholders who may be subject to special rules, such as insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, shareholders holding Fund shares through tax-advantaged accounts (such as 401(k) Plan Accounts or Individual Retirement Accounts), financial institutions, broker-dealers, entities that are not organized under the laws of the United States or a political subdivision thereof, persons who are neither citizens nor residents of the United States, shareholders holding Fund shares as part of a hedge, straddle, or conversion transaction, and shareholders who are subject to the U.S. federal alternative minimum tax.

The Trust has not requested and will not request an advance ruling from the IRS as to the U.S. federal income tax matters described below. The IRS could adopt positions contrary to those discussed below and such positions could be sustained. In addition, the following discussion and the discussions in the prospectuses applicable to each shareholder address only some of the U.S. federal income tax considerations generally affecting investments in the Funds. Prospective shareholders are urged to consult with their own tax advisors and financial planners regarding the U.S. federal tax consequences of an investment in a Fund, the application of state, local, or foreign laws, and the effect of any possible changes in applicable tax laws on their investment in the Funds.

Qualification as a Regulated Investment Company

It is intended that each Fund qualify as a “regulated investment company” under Subchapter M of Subtitle A, Chapter 1 of the Code. Each Fund will be treated as a separate entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Thus, the provisions of the Code applicable to regulated investment companies generally will apply separately to each Fund, even though each Fund is a series of the Trust. Furthermore, each Fund will separately determine its income, gains, losses, and expenses for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

In order to qualify for the special tax treatment accorded regulated investment companies and their shareholders, each Fund must, among other things, derive at least 90% of its gross income each taxable year generally from (i) dividends, interest, certain payments with respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities or foreign currencies, or other income attributable to its business of investing in such stock, securities or foreign currencies (including, but not limited to, gains from options, futures or forward contracts) and (ii) net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership, as defined below. In general, for purposes of this 90% gross income requirement, income derived from a partnership (other than a qualified publicly traded partnership) will be treated as qualifying income only to the extent such income is attributable to items of income of the partnership which would be qualifying income if realized directly by the regulated investment company. However, 100% of the net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership (defined as a partnership (x) the interests in which are traded on an established securities market or readily tradable on a secondary market or the substantial equivalent thereof, (y) that derives at least 90% of its income from the passive income sources defined in Code Section 7704(d), and (z) that derives less than 90% of its income from the qualifying income described in clause (i) above) will be treated as qualifying income. Certain of a Fund’s investments in master limited partnerships (MLPs), if any, may

 

172


Table of Contents

qualify as interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, although in general the passive loss rules do not apply to a regulated investment company, such rules do apply to a regulated investment company with respect to items attributable to an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership.

Each Fund must also diversify its holdings so that, at the end of each quarter of the Fund’s taxable year: (i) at least 50% of the fair market value of its total assets consists of (A) cash and cash items (including receivables), U.S. government securities and securities of other regulated investment companies, and (B) securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (A)) to the extent such securities do not exceed 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets and are not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (ii) not more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s total assets consists of the securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (i)(A)), the securities of two or more issuers the Fund controls and which are engaged in the same, similar, or related trades or businesses, or the securities of one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, for purposes of meeting this diversification requirement, the term “outstanding voting securities of such issuer” includes the equity securities of a qualified publicly traded partnership and in the case of a Fund’s investments in loan participations, the Fund shall treat both the financial intermediary and the issuer of the underlying loan as an issuer. The qualifying income and diversification requirements described above may limit the extent to which a Fund can engage in certain derivative transactions, as well as the extent to which it can invest in MLPs.

In addition, each Fund generally must distribute to its shareholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income for the taxable year, which generally includes its ordinary income and the excess of any net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss, and at least 90% of its net tax-exempt interest income (if any) for the taxable year.

If a Fund qualifies as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment, it generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on any of the investment company taxable income and net capital gain (i.e., the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) it distributes to its shareholders (including Capital Gain Dividends, as defined below). Each Fund generally intends to distribute at least annually substantially all of its investment company taxable income (computed without regard to the dividends-paid deduction) and substantially all of its net capital gain. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to U.S. federal income taxation. Any investment company taxable income retained by a Fund will be subject to tax at regular corporate rates.

In addition, although each Fund generally intends to distribute all of its net capital gain, a Fund may determine to retain for investment all or a portion of its net capital gain. If a Fund retains any net capital gain, it will be subject to a tax at regular corporate rates on the amount retained, but may designate the retained amount as undistributed capital gains in a notice to its shareholders, who (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as long-term capital gain, their shares of such undistributed amount, and (ii) will be entitled to credit their proportionate shares of the tax paid by the Fund on such undistributed amount against their U.S. federal income tax liabilities, if any, and to claim refunds to the extent the credit exceeds such liabilities. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, the tax basis of shares owned by a shareholder of a Fund will be increased by an amount equal under current law to the difference between the amount of undistributed capital gains included in the shareholder’s gross income under clause (i) of the preceding sentence and the tax deemed paid by the shareholder under clause (ii) of the preceding sentence.

In determining its net capital gain for Capital Gain Dividend purposes, a regulated investment company generally must treat any net capital loss or any net long-term capital loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year. Treasury Regulations generally permit a regulated investment company, in determining its taxable income, to elect to treat all or part of any net capital loss, any net long-term capital loss or any foreign currency loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year.

 

173


Table of Contents

 

In order to comply with the distribution requirements described above applicable to regulated investment companies, a Fund generally must make the distributions in the same taxable year that it realizes the income and gain, although in certain circumstances, a Fund may make the distributions in the following taxable year in respect of income and gains from the prior taxable year. Shareholders generally are taxed on any distributions from a Fund in the year they are actually distributed. If a Fund declares a distribution to shareholders of record in October, November or December of one calendar year and pays the distribution by January 31 of the following calendar year, however, the Fund and its shareholders will be treated as if the Fund paid the distribution by December 31 of the earlier year.

If, for any taxable year, a Fund fails to qualify as a regulated investment company accorded special tax treatment under the Code, it will be taxed in the same manner as an ordinary corporation without any deduction for its distributions to shareholders, and all distributions from the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits (including any distributions of its net tax-exempt income and net long-term capital gains) to its shareholders will be taxable to shareholders as dividend income. In addition, the Fund could be required to recognize unrealized gains, pay substantial taxes and interest and make substantial distributions before requalifying as a regulated investment company.

Excise Tax

If a Fund fails to distribute by December 31 of each calendar year at least the sum of 98% of its ordinary income for that year (excluding capital gains and losses) and 98% of its capital gain net income (adjusted for net ordinary losses) for the 1-year period ending on October 31 of that year (or November 30 or December 31 of that year if the Fund is permitted to elect and so elects), and any of its ordinary income and capital gain net income from previous years that were not distributed during such years, the Fund will be subject to a nondeductible 4% excise tax on the undistributed amounts. For these purposes, a Fund will be treated as having distributed any amount on which it has been subject to corporate income tax in the taxable year ending within the calendar year. Each Fund generally intends to actually distribute or be deemed to have distributed substantially all of its ordinary income and capital gain net income, if any, by the end of each calendar year and, thus, expects not to be subject to the excise tax. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to the excise tax. Moreover, each Fund reserves the right to pay an excise tax rather than make an additional distribution when circumstances warrant (for example, if the amount of excise tax to be paid is deemed de minimis by a Fund).

Capital Loss Carryforwards

Subject to certain limitations, a Fund is permitted to carry forward a net capital loss from any year to offset its capital gains, if any, realized during the eight years following the year of the loss. A Fund’s capital loss carryforward is treated as a short-term capital loss in the year to which it is carried. If future capital gains are offset by carried forward capital losses, such future capital gains are not subject to fund-level U.S. federal income taxation, regardless of whether they are distributed to shareholders. Accordingly, the Funds do not expect to distribute any such offsetting capital gains. The Funds cannot carry back or carry forward any net operating losses.

Equalization Accounting

Each Fund may use the so-called “equalization method” of accounting to allocate a portion of its “accumulated earnings and profits,” which generally equals a Fund’s undistributed net investment income and realized capital gains, with certain adjustments, to redemption proceeds. This method permits a Fund to achieve more balanced distributions for both continuing and redeeming shareholders. Although using this method generally will not affect a Fund’s total returns, it may reduce the amount of income and gains that the Fund would otherwise distribute to continuing shareholders by reducing the effect of redemptions of Fund shares on Fund distributions to shareholders. The IRS has not sanctioned the particular equalization method used by the Funds, and thus a Fund’s use of this method may be subject to IRS scrutiny.

 

174


Table of Contents

 

Investment through Master Portfolios

Some Funds seek to continue to qualify as regulated investment companies by investing their assets through one or more Master Portfolios. Each Master Portfolio will be treated as a non-publicly traded partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes rather than as a regulated investment company or a corporation under the Code. Under the rules applicable to a non-publicly traded partnership, a proportionate share of any interest, dividends, gains and losses of a Master Portfolio will be deemed to have been realized (i.e., “passed through”) to its investors, including the corresponding Fund, regardless of whether any amounts are actually distributed by the Master Portfolio. Each investor in a Master Portfolio will be taxed on such share, as determined in accordance with the governing instruments of the particular Master Portfolio, the Code and Treasury Regulations, in determining such investor’s U.S. federal income tax liability. Therefore, to the extent a Master Portfolio were to accrue but not distribute any income or gains, the corresponding Fund would be deemed to have realized its proportionate share of such income or gains without receipt of any corresponding distribution. However, each of the Master Portfolios will seek to minimize recognition by its investors (such as a corresponding Fund) of income and gains without a corresponding distribution. Furthermore, each Master Portfolio intends to manage its assets, income and distributions in such a way that an investor in a Master Portfolio will be able to continue to qualify as a regulated investment company by investing its assets through the Master Portfolio.

Taxation of Fund Investments

In general, realized gains or losses on the sale of securities held by a Fund will be treated as capital gains or losses, and long-term capital gains or losses if the Fund has held or is deemed to have held the securities for more than one year at the time of disposition.

If a Fund purchases a debt obligation with original issue discount (OID) (generally a debt obligation with an issue price less than its stated principal amount, such as a zero-coupon bond), the Fund may be required to annually include in its income a portion of the OID as ordinary income, even though the Fund will not receive cash payments for such discount until maturity or disposition of the obligation. Inflation-protected bonds generally can be expected to produce OID income as their principal amounts are adjusted upward for inflation. In general, gains recognized on the disposition of (or the receipt of any partial payment of principal on) a debt obligation (including a municipal obligation) purchased by a Fund at a market discount, generally at a price less than its principal amount, will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the portion of market discount which accrued, but was not previously recognized pursuant to an available election, during the term that the Fund held the debt obligation. A Fund generally will be required to make distributions to shareholders representing the OID or market discount (if an election is made by the Fund to accrue market discount over the holding period of the applicable debt obligation) on debt securities that is currently includible in income, even though the cash representing such income may not have been received by the Fund. Cash to pay such distributions may be obtained from borrowing or from sales proceeds of securities held by a Fund which the Fund otherwise might have continued to hold; obtaining such cash might be disadvantageous for the Fund.

In addition, payment-in-kind securities similarly will give rise to income which is required to be distributed and is taxable even though a Fund receives no cash interest payment on the security during the year. A portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations (such as high-yield corporate debt securities) may not (and interest paid on debt obligations owned by a Fund that are considered for tax purposes to be payable in the equity of the issuer or a related party will not) be deductible to the issuer, possibly affecting the cash flow of the issuer.

If a Fund invests in debt obligations that are in the lowest rating categories or are unrated, including debt obligations of issuers not currently paying interest or who are in default, special tax issues may exist for the Fund. Tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as whether a Fund should recognize market discount on a debt obligation and, if so, the amount of market discount the Fund should recognize, when a Fund may cease to accrue interest, OID or market discount, when and to what extent deductions may be taken for bad debts or

 

175


Table of Contents

worthless securities and how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income. These and other related issues will be addressed by a Fund when, as and if it invests in such securities, in order to seek to ensure that it distributes sufficient income to preserve its status as a regulated investment company and does not become subject to U.S. federal income or excise tax.

If an option granted by a Fund is sold, lapses or is otherwise terminated through a closing transaction, such as a repurchase by the Fund of the option from its holder, the Fund generally will realize a short-term capital gain or loss, depending on whether the premium income is greater or less than the amount paid by the Fund in the closing transaction. Some capital losses realized by a Fund in the sale, exchange, exercise or other disposition of an option may be deferred if they result from a position that is part of a “straddle,” discussed below. If securities are sold by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a covered call option granted by it, the Fund generally will add the premium received to the sale price of the securities delivered in determining the amount of gain or loss on the sale. If securities are purchased by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a put option written by it, the Fund generally will subtract the premium received from its cost basis in the securities purchased.

Some regulated futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity, listed options that may be used by a Fund will be deemed “Section 1256 contracts.” A Fund will be required to “mark to market” any such contracts held at the end of the taxable year by treating them as if they had been sold on the last day of that year at market value. Sixty percent of any net gain or loss realized on all dispositions of Section 1256 contracts, including deemed dispositions under the “mark-to-market” rule, generally will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss, and the remaining 40% will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss, although certain foreign currency gains and losses from such contracts may be treated as ordinary income or loss as described below. These provisions may require a Fund to recognize income or gains without a concurrent receipt of cash. Transactions that qualify as designated hedges are exempt from the mark-to-market rule and the “60%/40%” rule and may require the Fund to defer the recognition of losses on certain futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity options.

Foreign exchange gains and losses realized by a Fund in connection with certain transactions involving foreign currency-denominated debt securities, certain options, futures contracts, forward contracts and similar instruments relating to foreign currency, foreign currencies, or payables or receivables denominated in a foreign currency are subject to Section 988 of the Code, which generally causes such gains and losses to be treated as ordinary income or loss and may affect the amount and timing of recognition of the Fund’s income. Under future Treasury Regulations, any such transactions that are not directly related to a Fund’s investments in stock or securities (or its options contracts or futures contracts with respect to stock or securities) may have to be limited in order to enable the Fund to satisfy the 90% qualifying income test described above. If the net foreign exchange loss exceeds a Fund’s net investment company taxable income (computed without regard to such loss) for a taxable year, the resulting ordinary loss for such year will not be available as a carryforward and thus cannot be deducted by the Fund or its shareholders in future years.

Offsetting positions held by a Fund involving certain derivative instruments, such as forward, futures and options contracts, may be considered, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to constitute “straddles.” “Straddles” are defined to include “offsetting positions” in actively traded personal property. The tax treatment of “straddles” is governed by Section 1092 of the Code which, in certain circumstances, overrides or modifies the provisions of Section 1256. If a Fund is treated as entering into a “straddle” and at least one (but not all) of the Fund’s positions in derivative contracts comprising a part of such straddle is governed by Section 1256 of the Code, described above, then such straddle could be characterized as a “mixed straddle.” A Fund may make one or more elections with respect to “mixed straddles.” Depending upon which election is made, if any, the results with respect to a Fund may differ. Generally, to the extent the straddle rules apply to positions established by a Fund, losses realized by the Fund may be deferred to the extent of unrealized gain in any offsetting positions. Moreover, as a result of the straddle rules, short-term capital loss on straddle positions may be recharacterized as long-term capital loss, and long-term capital gain may be characterized as short-term capital gain. In addition, the existence of a straddle may affect the holding period of the offsetting positions. As a result, the straddle rules

 

176


Table of Contents

could cause distributions that would otherwise constitute “qualified dividend income” or qualify for the dividends-received deduction to fail to satisfy the applicable holding period requirements (as described below). Furthermore, the Fund may be required to capitalize, rather than deduct currently, any interest expense and carrying charges applicable to a position that is part of a straddle, including any interest on indebtedness incurred or continued to purchase or carry any positions that are part of a straddle. The application of the straddle rules to certain offsetting Fund positions can therefore affect the amount, timing, and character of distributions to shareholders, and may result in significant differences from the amount, timing and character of distributions that would have been made by the Fund if it had not entered into offsetting positions in respect of certain of its portfolio securities.

If a Fund enters into a “constructive sale” of any appreciated financial position in stock, a partnership interest, or certain debt instruments, the Fund will be treated as if it had sold and immediately repurchased the property and must recognize gain (but not loss) with respect to that position. A constructive sale of an appreciated financial position occurs when a Fund enters into certain offsetting transactions with respect to the same or substantially identical property, including, but not limited to: (i) a short sale; (ii) an offsetting notional principal contract; (iii) a futures or forward contract; or (iv) other transactions identified in future Treasury Regulations. The character of the gain from constructive sales will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the appreciated financial position. Losses realized from a sale of a position that was previously the subject of a constructive sale will be recognized when the position is subsequently disposed of. The character of such losses will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the position beginning with the date the constructive sale was deemed to have occurred and the application of various loss deferral provisions in the Code. Constructive sale treatment does not apply to certain closed transactions, including if such a transaction is closed on or before the 30th day after the close of the Fund’s taxable year and the Fund holds the appreciated financial position unhedged throughout the 60-day period beginning with the day such transaction was closed.

The amount of long-term capital gain a Fund may recognize from certain derivative transactions with respect to interests in certain pass-through entities is limited under the Code’s constructive ownership rules. The amount of long-term capital gain is limited to the amount of such gain the Fund would have had if the Fund directly invested in the pass-through entity during the term of the derivative contract. Any gain in excess of this amount is treated as ordinary income. An interest charge is imposed on the amount of gain that is treated as ordinary income.

If a Fund makes a distribution of income received by the Fund in lieu of dividends (a “substitute payment”) with respect to securities on loan pursuant to a securities lending transaction, such income will not constitute qualified dividend income to individual shareholders and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction for corporate shareholders. Similar consequences may apply to repurchase and other derivative transactions. Similarly, to the extent that a Fund makes distributions of income received by such Fund in lieu of tax-exempt interest with respect to securities on loan, such distributions will not constitute exempt-interest dividends (defined below) to shareholders.

In addition, a Fund’s transactions in securities and certain types of derivatives (e.g., options, futures contracts, forward contracts and swap agreements) may be subject to other special tax rules, such as the wash-sale rules or the short-sale rules, the effect of which may be to accelerate income to the Fund, defer losses to the Fund, cause adjustments in the holding periods of the Fund’s securities, convert long-term capital gains into short-term capital gains, and/or convert short-term capital losses into long-term capital losses. These rules could therefore affect the amount, timing and character of distributions to shareholders.

Certain of a Fund’s investments in derivative instruments and foreign currency-denominated instruments, as well as any of its foreign currency transactions and hedging activities, are likely to produce a difference between its book income and its taxable income. If a Fund’s book income exceeds the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the distribution (if any) of such excess generally will be treated as (i) a dividend to the extent of the Fund’s remaining earnings and profits (including earnings and profits arising from tax-exempt

 

177


Table of Contents

income), (ii) thereafter, as a return of capital to the extent of the recipient’s basis in its shares, and (iii) thereafter, as gain from the sale or exchange of a capital asset. If a Fund’s book income is less than the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the Fund could be required to make distributions exceeding book income to qualify as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment.

Rules governing the U.S. federal income tax aspects of derivatives, including swap agreements, are in a developing stage and are not entirely clear in certain respects. Accordingly, while each Fund intends to account for such transactions in a manner it deems to be appropriate, an adverse determination or future guidance by the IRS with respect to these rules (which determination or guidance could be retroactive) may affect whether a Fund has made sufficient distributions, and otherwise satisfied the relevant requirements to maintain its qualification as a regulated investment company and avoid fund-level tax. Certain requirements that must be met under the Code in order for a Fund to qualify as a regulated investment company may limit the extent to which a Fund will be able to engage in certain derivatives transactions.

Any investment by a Fund in equity securities of a REIT may result in the Fund’s receipt of cash in excess of the REIT’s earnings; if the Fund distributes these amounts, these distributions could constitute a return of capital to Fund shareholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Investments in equity securities of a REIT or another regulated investment company also may require a Fund to accrue and distribute income not yet received. To generate sufficient cash to make the requisite distributions, the Fund may be required to sell securities in its portfolio (including when it is not advantageous to do so) that it otherwise would have continued to hold. Dividends received by the Fund from a REIT generally will not constitute qualified dividend income and will not qualify for the dividends-received deduction.

A Fund may invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in taxable mortgage pools (TMPs). Under an IRS notice, and Treasury Regulations that have yet to be issued but may apply retroactively, a portion of a Fund’s income (including income allocated to the Fund from a REIT, a regulated investment company or other pass-through entity) that is attributable to a residual interest in a REMIC or an equity interest in a TMP (referred to in the Code as an “excess inclusion”) will be subject to U.S. federal income tax in all events. This notice also provides, and the regulations are expected to provide, that excess inclusion income of a regulated investment company, such as a Fund, will be allocated to shareholders of the regulated investment company in proportion to the dividends received by such shareholders, with the same consequences as if the shareholders held the related interest directly. As a result, the Fund may not be a suitable investment for certain tax-exempt shareholders, as noted under “Tax-Exempt Shareholders” below.

In general, excess inclusion income allocated to shareholders (i) cannot be offset by net operating losses (subject to a limited exception for certain thrift institutions), (ii) will constitute unrelated business taxable income (UBTI) to entities (including a qualified pension plan, an individual retirement account, a 401(k) plan, a Keogh plan or certain other tax-exempt entities) subject to tax on UBTI, thereby potentially requiring such an entity that is allocated excess inclusion income, and otherwise might not be required to file a tax return, to file a tax return and pay tax on such income, and (iii) in the case of a foreign shareholder, will not qualify for any reduction in U.S. federal withholding tax.

Some amounts received by a Fund from its investments in MLPs will likely be treated as returns of capital because of accelerated deductions available with respect to the activities of MLPs. On the disposition of an investment in such an MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of economic gain from that asset (or if a Fund does not dispose of the MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of cash flow received by the Fund from the MLP in a later period), and the Fund must take such income into account in determining whether the Fund has satisfied its regulated investment company distribution requirements. The Fund may have to borrow or liquidate securities to satisfy its distribution requirements and meet its redemption requests, even though investment considerations might otherwise make it undesirable for the Fund to borrow money or sell securities at the time. In addition, distributions attributable to gain from the sale of MLPs that are characterized as ordinary income under the Code’s recapture provisions will be taxable to Fund shareholders as ordinary income.

 

178


Table of Contents

 

“Passive foreign investment companies” (PFICs) are generally defined as foreign corporations where at least 75% of their gross income for their taxable year is income from passive sources (such as certain interest, dividends, rents and royalties, or capital gains) or at least 50% of their assets on average produce such passive income. If a Fund acquires any equity interest in a PFIC, the Fund could be subject to U.S. federal income tax and interest charges on “excess distributions” received from the PFIC or on gain from the sale of such equity interest in the PFIC, even if all income or gain actually received by the Fund is timely distributed to its shareholders. Excess distributions and gain from the sale of interests in PFICs may be characterized as ordinary income even though, absent the application of PFIC rules, these amounts may otherwise have been classified as capital gain.

A Fund will not be permitted to pass through to its shareholders any credit or deduction for these special taxes and interest charges incurred with respect to a PFIC. Elections may be available that would ameliorate these adverse tax consequences, but such elections would require a Fund to include its share of the PFIC’s income and net capital gains annually, regardless of whether it receives any distribution from the PFIC (in the case of a “QEF election”), or to mark the gains (and to a limited extent losses) in its interests in the PFIC “to the market” as though the Fund had sold and repurchased such interests on the last day of the Fund’s taxable year, treating such gains and losses as ordinary income and loss (in the case of a “mark-to-market election”). The QEF and mark-to-market elections may require a Fund to recognize taxable income or gain without the concurrent receipt of cash and increase the amount required to be distributed by the Fund to avoid taxation. Making either of these elections therefore may require a Fund to liquidate other investments prematurely to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above, which also may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return. Each Fund may attempt to limit and/or manage its holdings in PFICs to minimize tax liability and/or maximize returns from these investments but there can be no assurance that it will be able to do so. Moreover, because it is not always possible to identify a foreign corporation as a PFIC in advance of acquiring shares in the corporation, a Fund may incur the tax and interest charges described above in some instances. Dividends paid by PFICs will not be eligible to be treated as qualified dividend income, as defined below.

In addition to the investments described above, prospective shareholders should be aware that other investments made by a Fund may involve complex tax rules that may result in income or gain recognition by the Fund without corresponding current cash receipts. Although each Fund seeks to avoid significant noncash income, such noncash income could be recognized by a Fund, in which case the Fund may distribute cash derived from other sources in order to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above. In this regard, a Fund could be required at times to liquidate investments prematurely in order to satisfy its minimum distribution requirements, which may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return.

Taxation of Distributions

Except for exempt-interest dividends (defined below) paid by a Fund, distributions paid out of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits, whether paid in cash or reinvested in the Fund, generally are deemed to be taxable distributions and must be reported by each shareholder who is required to file a U.S. federal income tax return. Dividends and distributions on a Fund’s shares are generally subject to U.S. federal income tax as described herein to the extent they do not exceed the Fund’s realized income and gains, even though such dividends and distributions may economically represent a return of a particular shareholder’s investment. Such distributions are likely to occur in respect of shares purchased at a time when the Fund’s net asset value reflects either unrealized gains, or realized but undistributed income or gains. Such realized income and gains may be required to be distributed even when the Fund’s net asset value also reflects unrealized losses. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, a Fund’s earnings and profits, described above, are determined at the end of the Fund’s taxable year and are allocated pro rata to distributions paid over the entire year. Distributions in excess of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits will first be treated as a return of capital up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares and then as capital gain. A return of capital is not taxable, but

 

179


Table of Contents

it reduces a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares, thus reducing any loss or increasing any gain on a subsequent taxable disposition by the shareholder of his or her shares. A Fund may make distributions in excess of its earnings and profits to a limited extent, from time to time.

For U.S. federal income tax purposes, distributions of investment income (except for exempt-interest dividends, defined below) are generally taxable as ordinary income, and distributions of gains from the sale of investments that a Fund owned (or is deemed to have owned) for one year or less will be taxable as ordinary income. Distributions properly designated by a Fund as capital gain dividends (Capital Gain Dividends) will be taxable to shareholders as long-term capital gain (to the extent such distributions do not exceed the Fund’s actual net long-term capital gain for the taxable year), regardless of how long a shareholder has held Fund shares, and do not qualify as dividends for purposes of the dividends-received deduction or as qualified dividend income (defined below). Each Fund will designate Capital Gain Dividends, if any, in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year.

Some states will not tax distributions made to individual shareholders that are attributable to interest a Fund earns on direct obligations of the U.S. government if the Fund meets the state’s minimum investment or reporting requirements, if any. Investments in GNMA or FNMA securities, bankers’ acceptances, commercial paper, and repurchase agreements collateralized by U.S. government securities generally do not qualify for tax-free treatment. This exemption may not apply to corporate shareholders.

Sales and Exchanges of Fund Shares

If a shareholder sells or exchanges his or her Fund shares, he or she generally will realize a taxable capital gain or loss on the difference between the amount received for the shares (or deemed received in the case of an exchange) and his or her tax basis in the shares. This gain or loss will be long-term capital gain or loss if he or she has held (or is deemed to have held) such Fund shares for more than one year at the time of the sale or exchange, and short-term capital gain or loss otherwise.

If a shareholder sells or exchanges Fund shares within 90 days of having acquired such shares and if, as a result of having initially acquired those shares, he or she subsequently pays a reduced sales charge on a new purchase of shares of the Fund or a different regulated investment company, the sales charge previously incurred in acquiring the Fund’s shares generally shall not be taken into account (to the extent the previous sales charges do not exceed the reduction in sales charges on the new purchase) for the purpose of determining the amount of gain or loss on the disposition, but generally will be treated as having been incurred in the new purchase. Also, if a shareholder realizes a loss on a disposition of Fund shares, the loss will be disallowed under “wash sale” rules to the extent that he or she purchases substantially identical shares within the 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the disposition. Any disallowed loss generally will be reflected in an adjustment to the tax basis of the purchased shares.

If a shareholder receives a Capital Gain Dividend or is deemed to receive a distribution of long-term capital gain with respect to any Fund share and such Fund share is held or treated as held for six months or less, then (unless otherwise disallowed) any loss on the sale or exchange of that Fund share will be treated as a long-term capital loss to the extent of the Capital Gain Dividend or deemed long-term capital gain distribution. If shares of a Fund are sold at a loss after being held for six months or less, the loss will be disallowed to the extent of any exempt-interest dividends (defined below) received on those shares.

Foreign Taxes

Amounts realized by a Fund from sources within foreign countries may be subject to withholding and other taxes imposed by such countries. Tax conventions between certain countries and the United States may reduce or eliminate such taxes. If more than 50% of the value of a Fund’s total assets at the close of its taxable year consists of securities of foreign corporations, the Fund will be eligible to file an annual election with the IRS

 

180


Table of Contents

pursuant to which the Fund may pass through to its shareholders on a pro rata basis foreign income and similar taxes paid by the Fund with respect to foreign securities that the Fund has held for at least the minimum holding periods specified in the Code and such taxes may be claimed, subject to certain limitations, either as a tax credit or deduction by the shareholders. A Fund that invests primarily or exclusively in other regulated investment companies would not be eligible for this election, even if the underlying regulated investment companies were eligible and did make the election.

Certain Funds may qualify for and make the election; however, even if a Fund qualifies for the election for any year, it may determine not to make the election for such year. If a Fund does not so qualify or qualifies but does not so elect, then shareholders will not be entitled to claim a credit or deduction with respect to foreign taxes paid by or withheld from payments to the Fund. A Fund will notify its shareholders within 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year if it has elected for the foreign taxes paid by it to “pass through” for that year.

In general, if a Fund makes the election, the Fund itself will not be permitted to claim a credit or deduction for foreign taxes paid in that year, and the Fund’s dividends-paid deduction will be increased by the amount of foreign taxes paid that year. Fund shareholders generally shall include their proportionate share of the foreign taxes paid by the Fund in their gross income and treat that amount as paid by them for the purpose of the foreign tax credit or deduction, provided that any applicable holding period and other requirements have been met. If a shareholder claims a credit for foreign taxes paid, in general, the credit will be subject to certain limits. A deduction for foreign taxes paid may be claimed only by shareholders that itemize their deductions.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Rates

As of the date of this SAI, the maximum stated U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to individuals generally is 35% for ordinary income and 15% for net long-term capital gain. Long-term capital gain rates applicable to individuals have been temporarily reduced — in general, to 15% with lower rates applying to taxpayers in the 10% and 15% rate brackets — for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

For taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011, U.S. federal income tax law also provides for a maximum individual U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to “qualified dividend income” equal to the highest net long-term capital gain rate, which, as described above, generally is 15%. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011. In general, “qualified dividend income” is income attributable to dividends received by a Fund from certain domestic and foreign corporations, as long as certain holding period and other requirements are met by the Fund with respect to the dividend-paying corporation’s stock and by the shareholders with respect to the Fund’s shares. If 95% or more of a Fund’s gross income (excluding net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) constitutes qualified dividend income, all of its distributions (other than Capital Gain Dividends) will be generally treated as qualified dividend income in the hands of individual shareholders, as long as they have owned their Fund shares for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the Fund’s ex-dividend date (or, in the case of certain preferred stock, 91 days during the 181-day period beginning 90 days before such date) and meet certain other requirements specified in the Code. In general, if less than 95% of a Fund’s income is attributable to qualified dividend income, then only the portion of the Fund’s distributions that is attributable to qualified dividend income and designated as such in a timely manner will be so treated in the hands of individual shareholders who meet the aforementioned holding period requirements. The rules regarding the qualification of Fund distributions as qualified dividend income are complex, including the holding period requirements. Individual Fund shareholders therefore are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners. Fixed income funds typically do not distribute significant amounts of qualified dividend income.

The maximum stated corporate U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to ordinary income and net capital gain is 35%. Actual marginal tax rates may be higher for some shareholders, for example, through reductions in deductions. Naturally, the amount of tax payable by any taxpayer will be affected by a combination of tax laws

 

181


Table of Contents

covering, for example, deductions, credits, deferrals, exemptions, sources of income and other matters. U.S. federal income tax rates are set to increase in future years under various “sunset” provisions of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Backup Withholding

Each Fund generally is required to withhold, and remit to the U.S. Treasury, subject to certain exemptions, an amount equal to 28% of all distributions and redemption proceeds (including proceeds from exchanges and redemptions in-kind) paid or credited to a Fund shareholder if (1) the shareholder fails to furnish the Fund with a correct “taxpayer identification number” (TIN) or has not certified to the Fund that withholding does not apply or (2) the IRS notifies the Fund that the shareholder’s TIN is incorrect or the shareholder is otherwise subject to backup withholding. These backup withholding rules may also apply to distributions that are properly designated as exempt-interest dividends (defined below). This backup withholding is not an additional tax imposed on the shareholder. The shareholder may apply amounts required to be withheld as a credit against his or her future U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS. If a shareholder fails to furnish a valid TIN upon request, the shareholder can also be subject to IRS penalties. Unless Congress enacts legislation providing otherwise, the rate of backup withholding is set to increase to 31% for amounts distributed or paid after December 31, 2010.

Tax-Deferred Plans

The shares of a Fund may be available for a variety of tax-deferred retirement and other tax-advantaged plans and accounts. Prospective investors should contact their tax advisors and financial planners regarding the tax consequences to them of holding Fund shares through such plans and/or accounts.

Corporate Shareholders

Subject to limitations and other rules, a corporate shareholder of a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction on Fund distributions attributable to dividends received by the Fund from domestic corporations, which, if received directly by the corporate shareholder, would qualify for such a deduction. For eligible corporate shareholders, the dividends-received deduction may be subject to certain reductions, and a distribution by a Fund attributable to dividends of a domestic corporation will be eligible for the deduction only if certain holding period and other requirements are met. These requirements are complex; therefore, corporate shareholders of the Funds are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners.

As discussed above, a portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations that a Fund may own may not be deductible to the issuer. If a portion of the interest paid or accrued on these obligations is not deductible, that portion will be treated as a dividend. In such cases, if the issuer of the obligation is a domestic corporation, dividend payments by a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction to the extent of the dividend portion of such interest.

Foreign Shareholders

For purposes of this discussion, “foreign shareholders” generally include: (i) nonresident alien individuals, (ii) foreign trusts (i.e., a trust other than a trust with respect to which a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over administration of that trust and one or more U.S. persons have authority to control substantial decisions of that trust), (iii) foreign estates (i.e., the income of which is not subject to U.S. tax regardless of source), and (iv) foreign corporations.

Generally, unless an exception applies, dividend distributions made to foreign shareholders other than Capital Gain Dividends and exempt-interest dividends (defined below) will be subject to non-refundable U.S. federal income tax withholding at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income

 

182


Table of Contents

tax treaty) even if they are funded by income or gains (such as portfolio interest, short-term capital gains, or foreign-source dividend and interest income) that, if paid to a foreign person directly, would not be subject to withholding. However, generally, for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions made to foreign shareholders and properly designated by a Fund as “interest-related dividends” were exempt from U.S. federal income tax withholding. The exemption for interest-related dividends did not apply to any distribution to a foreign shareholder (i) to the extent that the dividend was attributable to certain interest on an obligation if the foreign shareholder was the issuer or was a 10% shareholder of the issuer, (ii) that was within certain foreign countries that had inadequate information exchange with the United States, or (iii) to the extent the dividend was attributable to interest paid by a person that was a related person of the foreign shareholder and the foreign shareholder was a controlled foreign corporation. Interest-related dividends were generally attributable to the Fund’s net U.S.-source interest income of types similar to those not subject to U.S. federal income tax if earned directly by an individual foreign shareholder. In order to qualify as an interest-related dividend, the Fund was required to designate a distribution as such in a written notice mailed to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a distribution described above is “effectively connected” with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, is attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the recipient foreign shareholder, U.S. federal income tax withholding will not apply. Instead, the distribution will be subject to the tax, reporting and withholding requirements generally applicable to U.S. persons, and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the recipient foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation.

In general, a foreign shareholder’s capital gains realized on the disposition of Fund shares and distributions properly designated as Capital Gain Dividends are not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax, unless: (i) such gains or distributions are effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, are attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the foreign shareholder; (ii) in the case of an individual foreign shareholder, the shareholder is present in the U.S. for a period or periods aggregating 183 days or more during the year of the disposition of Fund shares or the receipt of Capital Gain Dividends and certain other conditions are met; or (iii) the Fund shares on which the foreign shareholder realized gain constitute U.S. real property interests (USRPIs, defined below) or, in certain cases, the distributions are attributable to gain from the sale or exchange of a USRPI, as discussed below. If the requirements of clause (i) are met, the tax, reporting and withholding requirements applicable to U.S. persons generally will apply to the foreign shareholder and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation. If the requirements of clause (i) are not met, but the requirements of clause (ii) are met, such gains and distributions will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income tax treaty). Please see below for a discussion of the tax implications to foreign shareholders in the event that clause (iii) applies. With respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions to a foreign shareholder attributable to a Fund’s net short-term capital gain in excess of its net long-term capital loss and designated as such by the Fund in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year (“short-term capital gain dividends”) were generally not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax unless clause (i), (ii) or (iii) above applied to such distribution.

It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend the exemptions from withholding for interest-related dividends and short-term capital gain dividends with respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Even if permitted to do so, each Fund provides no assurance that it would designate any distributions as interest-related dividends or short-term capital gain dividends.

In the case of shares held through an intermediary, even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment, no assurance can be made that the intermediary will respect such a designation, and an intermediary may withhold even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment. Foreign shareholders should contact their intermediaries regarding the application of these rules to their accounts.

 

183


Table of Contents

 

Special rules apply to distributions to foreign shareholders from a Fund if it is either a “U.S. real property holding corporation” (USRPHC) or would be a USRPHC but for the operation of certain exceptions from USRPI treatment for interests in domestically controlled REITs or regulated investment companies and not-greater-than-5% interests in publicly traded classes of stock in REITs or regulated investment companies. Additionally, special rules apply to the sale of shares in a Fund if it is a USRPHC. Generally, a USRPHC is a domestic corporation that holds USRPIs — defined generally as any interest in U.S. real property or any equity interest in a USRPHC — the fair market value of which equals or exceeds 50% of the sum of the fair market values of the corporation’s USRPIs, interests in real property located outside the United States and other assets. If a Fund holds (directly or indirectly) significant interests in REITs, it may be a USRPHC.

If a Fund is a USRPHC or would be a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, amounts the Fund receives from REITs derived from gains realized from USRPIs generally will retain their character as such in the hands of the Fund’s foreign shareholders. In the hands of a foreign shareholder that holds (or has held in the prior 12 months) more than a 5% interest in any class of the Fund, such amounts generally will be treated as gains “effectively connected” with the conduct of a “U.S. trade or business,” and subject to tax at graduated rates. Moreover, such shareholder generally will be required to file a U.S. income tax return for the year recognized, and the Fund must withhold 35% of the amount of such distribution. Otherwise, in the case of all other foreign shareholders (i.e., those whose interest in any class of the Fund did not exceed 5% at any time during the prior 12 months), such amounts generally will be treated as ordinary income (regardless of any designation by the Fund that such distribution is a Capital Gain Dividend), and the Fund must withhold 30% (or a lower applicable treaty rate) of the amount of the distribution paid to such shareholders. If a Fund is subject to the rules of this paragraph, its foreign shareholders may also be subject to “wash sale” rules to prevent the avoidance of the foregoing tax-filing and payment obligations through the sale and repurchase of Fund shares. Prior to January 1, 2010, if a Fund was a USRPHC or would have been a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, similar rules generally also applied to any non-REIT USRPI gains recognized by the Fund directly or indirectly through certain lower-tier regulated investment companies. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend such application for distributions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be.

In addition, if a Fund is a USRPHC, it generally must withhold 10% of the amount realized in redemption by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder, and that shareholder must file a U.S. income tax return for the year of the disposition of the USRPI and pay any additional tax due on the gain. Prior to January 1, 2010, such withholding generally was not required with respect to amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund if it was a domestically controlled USRPHC, or, in certain limited cases, if the Fund (whether or not domestically controlled) held substantial investments in regulated investment companies that were domestically controlled USRPHCs. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this exemption from withholding for redemptions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Unless and until such legislation is enacted, beginning on January 1, 2010, withholding is required in respect of amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder if the Fund is a USRPHC, without regard to whether the Fund or any regulated investment company in which it invests is domestically controlled.

In order to qualify for any exemptions from withholding described above or for lower withholding tax rates under income tax treaties, or to establish an exemption from backup withholding, a foreign shareholder must comply with applicable certification requirements relating to its foreign status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN or substitute form). Foreign shareholders should consult their tax advisors in this regard.

Special rules (including withholding and reporting requirements) apply to foreign partnerships and those holding Fund shares through foreign partnerships. In addition, additional considerations may apply to foreign trusts and foreign estates. Investors holding Fund shares through foreign entities should consult their tax advisors about their particular situation.

 

184


Table of Contents

 

If a Fund qualifies and makes an election to pass through foreign taxes to its shareholders, as described earlier, foreign shareholders of the Fund generally will be subject to increased U.S. federal income taxation without a corresponding benefit for the pass-through of foreign taxes.

A beneficial holder of shares who is a foreign person may be subject to state and local tax and to the U.S. federal estate tax in addition to the U.S. federal income tax referred to above.

Tax-Exempt Shareholders

Under current law, a Fund serves to “block” (that is, prevent the attribution to shareholders of) UBTI from being realized by tax-exempt shareholders. Notwithstanding this “blocking” effect, a tax-exempt shareholder could realize UBTI by virtue of its investment in a Fund if shares in the Fund constitute debt-financed property in the hands of the tax-exempt shareholder within the meaning of Code Section 514(b).

It is possible that a tax-exempt shareholder will also recognize UBTI if a Fund recognizes excess inclusion income (as described above) derived from direct or indirect investments in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Furthermore, any investment in residual interests of a CMO that has elected to be treated as a REMIC can create complex tax consequences, especially if the Fund has state or local governments or other tax-exempt organizations as shareholders.

In addition, special tax consequences apply to charitable remainder trusts (CRTs) that invest in regulated investment companies that invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Under legislation enacted in December 2006, a CRT, as defined in Section 664 of the Code, that realizes UBTI for a taxable year must pay an excise tax annually of an amount equal to such UBTI. Under IRS guidance issued in October 2006, a CRT will not recognize UBTI solely as a result of investing in a Fund to the extent that it recognizes excess inclusion income. Rather, if at any time during any taxable year a CRT (or one of certain other tax-exempt shareholders, such as the United States, a state or political subdivision, or an agency or instrumentality thereof, and certain energy cooperatives) is a record holder of a share in a Fund and the Fund recognizes excess inclusion income, then the Fund will be subject to a tax on that portion of its excess inclusion income for the taxable year that is allocable to such shareholders at the highest U.S. federal corporate income tax rate. The extent to which the IRS guidance remains applicable in light of the December 2006 legislation is unclear. To the extent permitted under the 1940 Act, each Fund may elect to specially allocate any such tax to the applicable CRT, or other shareholder, and thus reduce such shareholder’s distributions for the year by the amount of the tax that relates to such shareholder’s interest in the Fund. Each Fund has not yet determined whether such an election will be made. CRTs are urged to consult their tax advisors concerning the consequences of investing in a Fund.

Shareholder Reporting Requirements Regarding Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts and Other Foreign Financial Assets

Effective for taxable years beginning after March 18, 2010, certain individuals (and, if provided in future guidance, certain domestic entities) must disclose annually their interests in “specified foreign financial assets” on their U.S. federal income tax returns. It is currently unclear under what circumstances, if any, a shareholder’s (indirect) interest in a Fund’s “specified foreign financial assets,” if any, falls within this requirement. In addition, shareholders that are U.S. persons and own, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of a Fund by vote or value could be required to report annually their “financial interest” in the Fund’s “foreign financial accounts,” if any, on Treasury Department Form TD F 90-22.1, Report of Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts (FBAR). Shareholders should consult a tax advisor regarding the applicability to them of both of these reporting requirements.

 

185


Table of Contents

 

Other Reporting and Withholding Requirements

New rules enacted in March 2010 require the reporting to the IRS of direct and indirect ownership of foreign financial accounts and foreign entities by U.S. persons. Failure, including by a U.S. person, to provide this required information can result in a 30% withholding tax on certain payments (“withholdable payments”) made after December 31, 2012. Withholdable payments include U.S.-source dividends and interest, and gross proceeds from the sale or other disposal of property that can produce U.S.-source dividends or interest.

The IRS has issued only limited guidance with respect to these new rules; their scope remains unclear and potentially subject to material change. Very generally, it appears that any distribution made by a Fund after December 31, 2012 (or such later date as may be provided in future guidance) to a shareholder, including a distribution in redemption of shares and a distribution of income or gains otherwise exempt from withholding under the rules applicable to non-U.S. shareholders described above (e.g., Capital Gain Dividends), will be subject to the new 30% withholding requirement. Payments to a foreign shareholder that is a “foreign financial institution” will generally be subject to withholding, unless such shareholder enters into an agreement with the IRS. Payments to shareholders that are U.S. persons or foreign individuals will generally not be subject to withholding, so long as such shareholders provide a Fund with such certifications or other documentation as the Fund requires to comply with the new rules. Persons investing in a Fund through an intermediary should contact their intermediary regarding the application of the new reporting and withholding regime to their investments in the Fund.

Shareholders are urged to consult a tax advisor regarding this new reporting and withholding regime, in light of their particular circumstances.

Tax Shelter Reporting Regulations

Under Treasury Regulations, if a shareholder recognizes a loss of $2 million or more for an individual shareholder or $10 million or more for a corporate shareholder, the shareholder must file with the IRS a disclosure statement on Form 8886. Direct shareholders of portfolio securities are in many cases excepted from this reporting requirement, but under current guidance, shareholders of a regulated investment company are not excepted. Future guidance may extend the current exception from this reporting requirement to shareholders of most or all regulated investment companies. The fact that a loss is reportable under these regulations does not affect the legal determination of whether the taxpayer’s treatment of the loss is proper. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors to determine the applicability of these regulations in light of their individual circumstances.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to Tax-Exempt Funds

If, at the close of each quarter of a regulated investment company’s taxable year, at least 50% of the value of its total assets consists of obligations the interest on which is exempt from U.S. federal income tax under Section 103(a) of the Code, then the regulated investment company may qualify to pay “exempt-interest dividends” and pass through to its shareholders the tax-exempt character of its income from such obligations. Tax-exempt funds intends to so qualify and are designed to provide shareholders with a high level of income in the form of exempt-interest dividends, which are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax.

Distributions of capital gains or income not attributable to interest on tax-exempt funds’ tax-exempt obligations will not constitute exempt-interest dividends and will be taxable to shareholders as described earlier.

Not later than 60 days after the close of a tax-exempt fund’s taxable year, the tax-exempt fund will notify its shareholders of the portion of the distributions for the taxable year which constitutes exempt-interest dividends. In general, if an amount of the tax-exempt fund’s distribution designated as an exempt-interest dividend exceeds the fund’s net-exempt interest, the amount so qualifying as tax-exempt will be scaled back ratably to the amount of its net-exempt income. In such a case, each tax-exempt fund shareholder must proportionately reduce the

 

186


Table of Contents

amount of the dividend it treats as tax-exempt, and will generally include the excess income as a taxable dividend to the extent of certain disallowed deductions and thereafter as a return of capital. The deductibility of interest paid or accrued on indebtedness incurred by a shareholder to purchase or carry shares of a tax-exempt fund may be limited. The portion of such interest that is non-deductible generally equals the amount of such interest times the ratio of a tax-exempt fund’s exempt-interest dividends received by the shareholder to all of the tax-exempt fund’s dividends received by the shareholder (excluding Capital Gain Dividends and any capital gains required to be included in the shareholder’s long term capital gains in respect of capital gains retained by the tax-exempt fund, as described earlier).

Although exempt-interest dividends are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax, there may not be a similar exemption under the laws of a particular state or local taxing jurisdiction. Thus, exempt-interest dividends may be subject to state and local taxes; however, tax-exempt funds invests at least 80% of its net assets in municipal bonds that pay interest that is exempt not only from U.S. federal income tax, but also from the applicable state’s personal income tax (but not necessarily local taxes or taxes of other states). You should consult your tax advisor to discuss the tax consequences of your investment in a tax-exempt fund.

Tax-exempt interest on certain “private activity bonds” has been designated as a “tax preference item” and must be added back to taxable income for purposes of calculating U.S. federal alternative minimum tax (AMT). To the extent that a tax-exempt fund invests in certain private activity bonds, its shareholders will be required to report that portion of a tax-exempt fund’s distributions attributable to income from the bonds as a tax preference item in determining their U.S. federal AMT, if any. Shareholders will be notified of the tax status of distributions made by a tax-exempt fund. Persons who may be “substantial users” (or “related persons” of substantial users) of facilities financed by private activity bonds should consult their tax advisors before purchasing shares in a tax-exempt fund. In addition, exempt-interest dividends paid by a tax-exempt fund to a corporate shareholder are, with very limited exceptions, included in the shareholder’s “adjusted current earnings” as part of its U.S. federal AMT calculation. As of the date of this SAI, individuals are subject to the U.S. federal AMT at a maximum rate of 28% and corporations at a maximum rate of 20%. Shareholders with questions or concerns about the U.S. federal AMT should consult their own tax advisors.

Ordinarily, a tax-exempt fund relies on an opinion from the issuer’s bond counsel that interest on the issuer’s obligation will be exempt from U.S. federal income taxation. However, no assurance can be given that the IRS will not successfully challenge such exemption, which could cause interest on the obligation to be taxable and could jeopardize a tax-exempt fund’s ability to pay exempt-interest dividends. Similar challenges may occur as to state-specific exemptions. Also, from time to time legislation may be introduced or litigation may arise that would change the treatment of exempt-interest dividends. Such litigation or legislation may have the effect of raising the state or other taxes payable by shareholders on such dividends. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors for the current law on exempt-interest dividends.

A shareholder who receives Social Security or railroad retirement benefits should consult his or her tax advisor to determine what effect, if any, an investment in a tax-exempt fund may have on the federal taxation of such benefits. Exempt-interest dividends are included in income for purposes of determining the amount of benefits that are taxable.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

If, at the close of each quarter of its taxable year, at least 50% of the value of the total assets of a regulated investment company consists of obligations, which, when held by an individual, the interest therefrom is exempt from income taxation by California (California Exempt Securities), then the regulated investment company will be qualified to make distributions that are exempt from California state individual income tax (California exempt-interest distributions). For this purpose, California Exempt Securities generally are limited to California municipal securities and certain U.S. Government and U.S. Possession obligations. The California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund intends to qualify under the above requirements so that it can pay California exempt-interest distributions.

 

187


Table of Contents

 

Within sixty days after the close of its taxable year, the Fund will notify its shareholders of the portion of the distributions paid by the Fund that is exempt from California state individual income tax. The total amount of California exempt-interest distributions paid by the Fund with respect to any taxable year cannot exceed the excess of the amount of interest received by the Fund for such year on California Exempt Securities over any amounts that, if the Fund were treated as an individual, would be considered expenses related to tax exempt income or amortizable bond premium that would not be deductible under federal income or California state individual income tax law.

Interest on indebtedness incurred or continued by a shareholder in a taxable year to purchase or carry shares of the California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund is not deductible for California state individual income tax purposes if the Fund distributes California exempt-interest distributions during the shareholder’s taxable year.

The foregoing is only a summary of some of the important California state individual income tax considerations generally affecting the California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and its shareholders. No attempt is made to present a detailed explanation of the California state income tax treatment of the Fund or its shareholders, and this discussion is not intended as a substitute for careful planning. Further, it should be noted that the portion of any of the Fund’s distributions constituting California exempt-interest distributions is excludable from income for California state individual income tax purposes only. Any distributions paid to shareholders subject to California state franchise tax or California state corporate income tax may be taxable for such purposes. Accordingly, potential investors in the Fund, including, in particular, corporate investors which may be subject to either California franchise tax or California corporate income tax, should consult their own tax advisors with respect to the application of such taxes to the receipt of the Fund’s distributions and as to their own California state tax situation, in general.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the Fund’s exempt-interest distributions paid to residents of Georgia attributable to interest received by the Georgia Funds on tax-exempt obligations of the State of Georgia or its political subdivision or authorities and other Fund distributions attributable to interest received from U.S. Government obligations will be exempt from Georgia individual and corporate income taxes. There is no Georgia intangibles tax or other personal property tax applicable to the shares of the Georgia Funds owned by investors residing in Georgia. The Georgia intangibles tax was repealed by the Georgia General Assembly on March 21, 1996, further ratified by a Constitutional Amendment approved in the November 1996 General Election (GA. L 1996, P.130 § 9). The Georgia intangibles tax was repealed for taxable years beginning after January 1, 1996. Distributions attributable to capital gains realized from the sale of Georgia municipal bonds and U.S. Government obligations will be subject to the State of Georgia short-term or long-term capital gains tax, which follow the federal income tax treatment. Interest received by a Georgia resident from non-Georgia municipal state bonds and distributions received from mutual funds that derive income from non-Georgia municipal or state bonds will be subject to Georgia income tax.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s exempt-interest distributions attributable to interest received by the Fund on tax-exempt obligations of the state of Maryland or its political subdivisions or authorities, or obligations issued by the government of Puerto Rico, the U.S. Virgin Islands, Guam, American Samoa or their authorities (Maryland Municipal Bonds) and distributions attributable to gains from the disposition Maryland Municipal Bonds (other than obligations issued by U.S. possessions) or interest on U.S. Government obligations will be exempt from Maryland individual and corporate income taxes; any other Fund distributions will be subject to Maryland income tax. Fund shareholders will be informed annually regarding the portion of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s distributions that constitutes income exempt from Maryland income taxes. Maryland presently includes in Maryland taxable income a portion of certain items of tax preference as defined in the Code. Interest paid on certain private activity bonds constitutes such a tax

 

188


Table of Contents

preference if the bonds (i) are not Maryland Municipal Bonds or (ii) are Maryland Municipal Bonds issued by U.S. possessions. Accordingly, up to 50% of any distributions from the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund attributable to interest on such private activity bonds may not be exempt from Maryland state and local individual income taxes. Shares of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund will not be subject to the Maryland personal property tax.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s exempt-interest distributions attributable to interest received by the Fund on tax-exempt obligations of the State of North Carolina or its political subdivisions, commissions, authorities, agencies or non-profit educational institutions organized or chartered under the laws of North Carolina, or obligations issued by the United States or its possessions will be exempt from North Carolina individual and corporate income taxes. Although capital gain distributions generally are subject to tax in North Carolina, individual shareholders of the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund may deduct the amount of capital gain distributions (if any) attributable to the sale of certain obligations issued before July 1, 1995 for purposes of determining their North Carolina taxable income.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s exempt-interest distributions attributable to interest received by the Fund on tax-exempt obligations of the State of South Carolina, its political subdivisions or exempt interest upon obligations of the United States will be exempt from South Carolina income taxes. Distributions of capital gains or income not attributable to interest from tax-exempt obligations of the State of South Carolina, its political subdivisions or exempt interest on obligations of the United States may be subject to South Carolina income taxes.

Although distributions of capital gains and the gain recognized with respect to the sale or exchange of shares of the Fund may be subject to the South Carolina state income tax, individuals, estates and trusts are entitled to a deduction for South Carolina taxable income purposes equal to 44% of the net capital gain recognized in South Carolina during a taxable year. The definition of net capital gain for federal income tax purposes is utilized for purposes of this deduction. In the case of estates or trusts, the deduction is applicable only to income taxed to the estate or trust or individual beneficiaries and not income passed through to non-individual beneficiaries.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s distributions attributable to interest on (i) debt obligations of Virginia or its political subdivisions, and (ii) debt obligations of the United States and any authority, commission or instrumentality of the United States (including Puerto Rico, Guam, and the U.S. Virgin Islands), that are, in each case, backed by the full faith and credit of the borrowing government, will be exempt from Virginia income tax. Furthermore, any of the Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s distributions that are attributable to realized gains from dispositions of the foregoing debt obligations may also be exempt from Virginia income tax.

 

189


Table of Contents

 

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

As of August 31, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “principal holder “(i.e., owns of record or is known by the Trust to own beneficially 5% or more of any class of a Fund’s outstanding shares) is listed below.

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending February 28:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,676,047.3070    53.15%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   539,148.0880    46.01%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   726,305.3420    49.22%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FLR.

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   88,552.6660    6.00%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,573,901.9350    59.74%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN: JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   796,922.2030    7.24%

 

190


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN: JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   649,976.3610    5.91%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   551,871.7790    21.75%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   174,179.6740    6.86%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   123,752.4100    18.70%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   174,179.6740    6.86%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FLR.

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   54,949.4480    8.30%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

   38,546.0020    5.82%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   850,692.7110    29.03%

 

191


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FLR.

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   284,293.1510    9.70%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   808,790.6280    55.02%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   347,662.9250    23.65%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class Z

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

ASSOCIATES IN DIAGNOSTIC RADIOLOGY

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   93,358.6250    6.35%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   5,157,701.7550    18.42%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL RETIREMENT INS & ANN CO

FBO VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

200 WOOD AVE S

ISELIN NJ 08830-2769

   2,693,711.8980    9.62%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT

FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO, CA 94104-4151

   2,562,039.2280    9.15%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   22,515,7400    19.90%

 

192


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia International Value Fund

Class B

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   5,766.2090    5.10%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,227,586.1220    27.38%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   384,709.7330    8.58%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   34,350,727.8690    39.52%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS 101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   18,665,218.9790    21.47%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   7,422,644.5780    8.54%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,591,092.9160    69.20%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   72,603.6910    44.54%

 

193


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   59,048.1100    28.82%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   30,086.1110    14.68%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   51,769,526.9970    62.63%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT ADVISOR

COLUMBIA GROWTH ASST ALLOC-NY529

ATTN: JIM MARIN 3RD FL

245 SUMMER ST

BOSTON MA 02210-1133

   4,566,619.7210    5.52%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   441,376.6610    43.79%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class R

  

CHRISTI LAIRD FBO

COUNTRYWIDE MECHANICAL SYSTEMS

401K PROFIT SHARING PLAN & TRUST INC

9330 STEVENS RD STE A

SANTEE CA 92071-5639

   3,993.0390    42.27%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class R

  

NFS LLC CUST

HUNTINGTON NATIONAL BANK

FBO: EB ACCOUNTS

7 EASTON OVAL

COLUMBUS OH 43219-6010

   3,140.5300    33.25%

 

194


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

APPLIED RELIABILITY ENGINEERING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   2,173.7330    23.01%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,867,095.5940    99.96%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   32,562.941.9940    88.33%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,032,605.2870    5.51%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   1,883,865.3490    13.15%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

RELIANCE TRUST CO FBO

RETIREMENT PLANS SERVICED BY METLIFE

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   1,384,510.8550    9.67%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY LLC TTEE

FBO CLIENTS BENEFITS CLIENTS

401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   802,853.0910    5.60%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,368.6480    5.43%

 

195


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

NFS/FMTC ROLLOVER IRA

FBO GENE P ALVES

560 RAY ST

FALL RIVER MA 02720-7208

   7,847.3670      5.09%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   28,122,739.8040      25.35%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   18,508,025.9610      16.68%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) FOR LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   14,756,633.7260      13.30%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TRANSFERRED SAVINGS CUST FBO BANK OF AMERICA N.A

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   5,948,594.3730      5.36%   

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,303,603.5440      14.22

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   436,675.1230      7.89

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   585,984.5170      17.12

 

196


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

MICHAEL MIRE FBO

GULFSTREAM SERVICES INC 401K PSP & TRUST

103 DICKSON RD

HOUMA LA 70363-7306

   82,420.9220      78.32

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

COMMUNITY BANK NA AS CUST

FBO SIMED 1165(E) RETIREMENT PLAN

6 RHOADS DR STE 7

UTICA NY 13502-6317

   19,418.2520      18.45

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,109,406.6510      99.89

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   41,482,188.4480      34.60

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN: NORMA AJA

P.O. BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   18,275,848.6640      15.24

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   13,376,089.4290      11.16%   

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   11,199,371.5990      7.70%   

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MNGT SVC

FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

ATTN PRUCHOICE UNTI

194 WOOD AVE S

ISELIN NJ 08830-2710

   7,408,061.1970      5.10%   

 

197


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,623,892.5810    17.14%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   904,907.5070    9.55%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,932,724.7210    26.51%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   6,482,084.5310    12.33%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   2,697,499.8120    5.13%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   353,713.0210    10.76%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   13,447,698.8280    16.00%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   10,040,499.7850    11.95%

 

198


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMER

4800 DEER LAKE DR E

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,446,356.2090    10.05%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

   6,869,310.5170    8.17%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-415

   6,773,805.6020    8.06%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

FIDELITY INVESTMENTS INST L OPS CO

FIIOC AS AGENT FOR CERTAIN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

100 MAGELLAN WAY

COVINGTON KY 41015-1999

   6,751,574.6710    8.03%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MNGT SVC

FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

ATTN: PROCHOICE UNIT

194 WOOD AVE S

ISELIN NJ 08830-2710

   15,967,435.7510    21.28%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,736,281.8880    11.64%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,345,070.0140    48.70%

 

199


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,275,537.7720    53.82%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   1,209,057.3920    7.86%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   9,804,286.9370    19.67%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,293,123.4110    12.63%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

4800 DEER LAKE DR E

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   4,372,982.4200    8.77%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-415

   4,053,356.7700    8.13%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class A

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,467.7520    52.68%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

WILLIAM C LIVINGSTON

BRONAH M LIVINGSTON

4254 RUSTLING WOODS DR

DENVER NC 28037-5463

   13,003.8390    5.46%

 

200


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class C

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,000.0000    66.31%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,730.8890    7.28%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class R

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,246.4790    99.59%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class Z

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,689.4900    86.03%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA IRA

CHARLES J HOWELL

600 UNIVERSITY ST STE 1725

SEATTLE WA 98101-4120

   16,738.2680    11.46%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   9,616,817.1710    16.34%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY
SMITH BARNEY

HARBOSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   4,907,913.3890    8.34%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   3,347,885.8880    5.69%

 

201


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,121,699.8620    44.24%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   182,046.8070    7.18%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   12,100,883.2820    53.69%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   1,801,294.0250    7.99%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2I, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   1,300,891.0260    5.77%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD CT 06104-2999

   404,351.1090    44.63%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   67,289.3190    7.43%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   24,433,604.5490    25.46%

 

202


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   17,430,361.2730    18.17%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

   9,804,031.1820    10.22%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACOUNT

FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   7,570,908.3860    7.89%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,493,803.5100    10.55%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   403,891.6150    26.24%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   139,719.1580    9.08%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   797,783.6690    19.90%

 

203


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   522,218.4880    13.03%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   227,244.8610    5.67%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

ORCHARD TRUST CO TTEE

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401K

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   47,994.4000    15.33%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

DEARBORN MID WEST CONVEYOR CO 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   46,382.8210    14.82%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

NTC & CO

CUST BODE CALL & STROUPE

FBO BODE CALL & STROUPE

P.O. BOX 173859

DENVER CO 80217-3859

   32,856.3270    10.49%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   22,172.4570    7.08%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD CT 06104-2999

   17,859.8770    5.70%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

GPC SECURITIES INC AGENT FOR RELIANCE TRUST COMPANY FBO

WHITEMAN LUMBER COMPANY 401K PLAN

P.O. BOX 79377

ATLANTA GA 30357-7377

   16,562.9740    5.29%

 

204


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   54,208,961.1110      61.99%   

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class Z

  

VANGUARD FIDUCIARY TRUST COMPANY NATIONS FUNDS

P.O. BOX 2600 VM 613

ATTN OUTSIDE FUNDS

VALLEY FORGE PA 19482-2600

   8,110,560.1520      9.27%   

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class Z

  

TEXAS CHILDREN’S HOSPITAL FOUNDATION

1919 S.BRAESWOOD

HOUSTON TX 77030-4412

   6,027,850.6560      6.89%   

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

NEW YORK LIFE TRUST COMPANY

690 CANTON ST STE 100

WESTWOOD MA 02090-2324

   3,380,978.2100      16.08

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

PIMS/PRUDENTIAL RETIREMENT

AS NOMINEE FOR THE TTEE/CUST

MAGELLAN HEALTH SERVICE INC

6950 COLUMBIA GATEWAY DR

COLUMBIA MD 21046-2706

   1,349,770.7930      6.42

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY
LL TTEE

FBO EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   1,224,647.4640      5.82

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

JPMORGAN CHASE TRUSTEE CUST

FBO ERICSSON CAPITAL ACCUMULATION AND SAVINGS PLAN

93 WARD PKWY

KANSAS CITY MO 64114-3317

   1,093,460.0330      5.20

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   68,401,274.4280      35.19

 

205


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   42,191,802.7500      21.70

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) FOR LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   25,762,004.0100      13.25

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,435,760.4780      6.29

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class A

  

ING LIFE INSURANCE & ANNUITY CO

ING FUND OPERATIONS

1 ORANGE WAY

WINDSOR CT 06095-4773

   6,528,034.4580      5.52

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   268,576.0030      6.18

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   239,097.0000      5.50

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,036,617.8700      21.09

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   1,340,383.1390      9.31

 

206


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

GREAT WEST LIFE & ANNUITY

C/O FASCORE LLC

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   15,502,397.4310      61.70

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD, CT 06104-2999

   1,534,665.8730      6.11

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Y

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   1,138.9930      100.00

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   41,442,903.6130      19.47

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   31,705,425.6820      14.89

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY ST

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   18,626,637.9240      8.75

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   18,364,780.9080      8.63

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   554,599.2450      26.38

 

207


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   35,532.3860      42.61

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   49,487.8760      39.83

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class C

  

SUMMERVILLE PEDIACTRICS PA

PROFIT SHARING PLAN

312 MIDLAND PARKWAY

SUMMERVILLE SC 29485-8102

   9,433.2020      7.59

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   7,629.9760      6.14

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

GPC SECURITIES INC AGENT FOR RELIANCE TRUST COMPANY FBO

VIRGINIA LAB SUPPLY 401K PSP

PO BOX 79377

ATLANTA GA 30357-7377

   11,0726210      50.08

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   5,494.4590      24.85

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

APPLIED RELIABILITY ENGINEERING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   2,132.3010      9.65

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

MIRAMAR LABS 401K PROFIT-SHARING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   2,075.4350      9.39

 

208


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   65,820,152.9370      57.36

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   16,342,850.5470      14.24

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT ADVISORS INC FBO COLUMBIA MASTERS INTERNATIONAL EQUITY PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM MARIN

ONE FINANCIAL CENTER FL 3

BOSTON MA 02111-2694

   8,298,492.9220      7.23

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Class Z

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   1,088,418.8280      100.00

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,208,893.4990      17.25

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   79,205.3320      29.66

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   81,238.5560      30.31

 

209


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN: PETER BOOTH, 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   19,678.8020      7.34

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   12,402,334.2720      59.82

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class Z

  

GPC SECURITIES INC AGENT FOR RELIANCE TRUST COMPANY FBO

PLEXUS CORP. 401(K) SAVINGS PLAN

P.O. BOX 79377

ATLANTA GA 30357-7377

   1,435,274.1330      6.92

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT

FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   757,484.0330      8.95

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   624,406.6530      7.37

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY LLC TTEE

FBO EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   546,792.3390      6.46

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

NEW YORK LIFE TRUST COMPANY

690 CANTON ST STE 100

WESTWOOD MA 02090-2344

   493,365.5470      5.83

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

FIFTH THIRD BANK TTEE

FBO VARIOUS FASCORE LL RECORDKEPT

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   455,118.2040      5.38%   

 

210


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   30,722,153.5870    33.60%

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN: NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   18,829,065.7420    20.59%

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) FOR LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   9,275,354.8020    10.14%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,440,867.1760    8.49%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class A

  

SUPPLEMENTAL INCOME TRUST FUND

P.O. BOX 8338

BOSTON MA 02266-8338

   2,428,315.2810    5.99%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   29,982.8160    11.96%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   423,829.9170    22.45%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   106,397.2450    5.64%

 

211


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD CT 06104-2999

   585,318.4600    27.98%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   134,873.3930    6.45%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

DCGT TRUSTEE & OR CUSTODIAN

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED PRIN ADVTG OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH ST

DES MOINES IA 50392-0001

   110,452.0530    5.28%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

FIFTH THIRD BANK TRUSTEE FBO

VARIOUS FASCORP RECORDKEPT PLANS

C/O FASCORP

8515 ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   106,948.3090    5.11%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,440,556.3770    15.58%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   12,133,939.7780    14.06%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   12,022,382.9750    13.93%

 

212


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

FIDELITY INVESTMENTS INST L OPS CO

FIIOC AS AGENT FOR CERTAIN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

100 MAGELLAN WAY

COVINGTON KY 41015-1999

   6,938,111.8800    8.04%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   5,423,694.2660    6.29%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   4,800,292.2420    5.56%

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,488,370.7030      75.67

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   43.393.8240      61.67

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC. FBO

BARBARA PHILLIPS

933 111TH AVE NE APT 532

BELLEVUE WA 98004-8544

   11,416.4560      26.76

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   6,707.4070      15.72

 

213


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   4,001.9850      9.38

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC. FBO

RAYDEAN RANDLETT

TRADITIONAL IRA

1135 HIDDEN OAKS DR

MENLO PARK CA 94025-6042

   2,679.5480      6.28

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

AMERICAN ENTERPRISE INVESTMENT SVCS

P.O. BOX 9446

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55440-9446

   2,444.9880      5.73

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,095,457.0520      99.53

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   594,993.7540      48.17

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC. FBO

THELMA STEWART MANAGEMENT

COMPANY, LLC

3031 W MARCH LN STE 123

STOCKTON CA 95219-6567

   192,667.5230      15.60

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   21,665.8350      96.98

 

214


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   151,043.7160      74.34

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

EXEMPTION TR CREATED UNDER 2004 SICHI FAM TRUST TR

2555 TODD CT

ARCATA CA 95521-5147

   17,771.9890      8.75

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   20,402,583.1980      91.11

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   500,329.0080      28.54

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

   236,234.9350      13.47

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund-

Class A

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   119,832.3740      6.83

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   34,565.4740      49.17

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   7,603.0950      10.82

 

215


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

STEVE G LYMAN & ALIDA B LYMAN

4492 HAVERSTRAW DRIVE

DUNWOODY GA 30338-6604

   5,352.1450      7.61

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

DAVID G HUNTER

4698 JERFFERSON TOWNSHIP LN

MARIETTA GA 30066-3826

   5,236.5320      7.45

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund-

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

WILSON S MOBLEY

2058 BRIAN WAY

DECATUR GA 30033-3826

   4,696.6730      6.68

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

   4,633.4730      6.59

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   91,354.3690      25.97

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

RUTH LAUTZ TR

RUTH LAUTZ TTEE

3315 PEACHTREE INDUSTRIAL BLVD

DECATUR GA 30033-3826

   23,749.9060      6.75

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   9,169,349.1900      95.51

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,761,279.4370      24.05

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

TRANSAMERICA LIFE INS COMPANY

1150 S OLIVE ST STE 2700

LOS ANGELES CA 90015-2211

   2,611,942.2490      16.70

 

216


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

TRANSAMERICA
FINANCIAL LIFE

1150 S OLIVE ST STE 2700

LOS ANGELES, CA 90015-2211

   851,362.5680      5.44

Columbia High Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,400,615.9210      44.23

Columbia High Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,132,847.9740      39.16

Columbia High Income Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   176,673.0810      6.11

Columbia High Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   53,986,303.5250      68.78

Columbia High Income Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   4,946,724.2400      6.30

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   10,224,400.9780      41.92

 

217


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,458,714.4550      48.57

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,766,178.7790      45.77

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   98,224.7790      44.29

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

BROWN & JONES REPORTING 401K PLAN

PO BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   29,283.8680      13.20

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MATC FBO

V RAO EMANDI M D

401K PSP & TRUST

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

   17,074.9380      7.70

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

ALBERT FREI & SONS INC

401K PLAN

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   12,602.1910      5.68

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

JOSEPH D POLK FBO

VANTAGE SYSTEMS INC

401K PSP & TRUST

4600 FORBES BLVD STE 250

LANHAM MD 20706-4359

   12,156.0160      5.48

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,996,804.0880      41.68

 

218


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,829,657.0880      38.19

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,640,599.3170      45.11

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   4,280,791.5270      50.89

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,701,596.4930      39.75

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   53,618.6240      30.15

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

RIVERFRONT STEEL 401K PLAN

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   25,358.8900      14.26

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

CLINICA CAMPESINA FAMILY HEALTH SER

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   23,993.0390      13.49

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

BROWN & JONES REPORTING 401K PLAN

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   18,004.5740      10.12

 

219


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

ALBERT FREI & SONS INC 401K PLAN

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   10,211.8830      5.74

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,165,077.3580      52.07

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,015,604.8400      24.42

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   419,856.2380      10.10

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,178,076.5960      37.90

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,862,336.8520      54.65

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   994,475.6320      42.97%   

 

220


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   32,943.8470    52.59%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

GROSSMONT FAMILY MEDICAL GROUP 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   3,540.0850    5.65%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

MIRAMAR LABS 401K PROFIT-SHARING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   5,874.0900    9.38%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

TRI-EAGLE SALES 401K PROFIT SHARING

PO BOX 10758

FARGO, ND 58106-0758

   7,257.2510    11.59%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   610,709.0520    29.68%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   582,540.4770    28.31%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   164,256.6900    7.98%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   463,712.1810    33.18%

 

221


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   271,383.8400    43.10%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   174,454.9530    35.56%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   126,661.8280    43.65%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   34,134.5560    11.76%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

ROBERT GLADSTONE

LESLIE GLADSTONE

2468 BELMONT RD NW

WASHINGTON DC 20008-1610

   358,822.2860    13.95%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   220,932.6060    8.59%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

MARK & MARY ANN RONALD TRUST

MARK & MARY ANN RONALD TTEES

7110 44TH ST

CHEVY CHASE MD 20815-6039

   132,477.3530    5.15%

 

222


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   9,001.3210    15.06%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

MARY A MICHELS

1658 HARDWICK RD

BALTIMORE MD 21286-8128

   5,894.5610    9.86%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

RALPH M VITALE SR

AUDREY J VITALE

3510 E JOPPA RD

BALTIMORE MD 21234-3313

   5,224.3900    8.74%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

ROBERT F ROHR & BARBARA M ROHR JT TEN

608 CHURCHILL RD

BEL AIR MD 21014-4245

   4,725.1010    7.91%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLERING LLC

2801 MARKET ST

SAINT LOUIS MO 63103-2523

   4,665.7530    7.81%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

   3,648.1450    6.10%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL

MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   3,596.6430    6.02%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   94,172.8150    22.35%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   88,159.2190    20.92%

 

223


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   11,376,071.5190    94.19%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   705,689.8330    12.28%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   115,823.5380    26.65%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   287,199.0170    24.11%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2. 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY, NJ 07311

   88,938.8090    7.47%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,664.9660    56.99%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MATC FBO

PROST DATA INC 401K

PSP & TRUST

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

   399,5780    13.68%

 

224


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

BRETT PEAKS FBO

LENOX VILLAGE DENTISTRY 401K PSP & TRUST

6905 LENOX VILLAGE DR

NASHVILLE TN 37211-7172

   386.9590    13.24%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MID ATLANTIC TRUST CO FBO

SAL OPPENHEIM JR & CIE 401K PSP & TRUST

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

   288.0130    9.86%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,650,697.2390    91.02%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT SERVICES LLC FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

100 MULBERRY ST

NEWARK NJ 07102-4056

   297,829.2580    8.26%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

MAURICIO CASTILLO TTEE

MAURICIO CASTILLO LIVING TRUST

416 HILLSBOROUGH ST

CHAPEL HILL NC 27514-3102

   278,666.2040    7.73%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

FRANK M DRENDEL

P.O. BOX 9212

HICKORY NC 28603-9212

   208,354.4670    5.78%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

FLOYD L & RAMONA

M MORRIS TR

FLOYD L MORRIS

3136 OLD LOWGAP RD

LOWGAP NC 27024-7416

   19,008.7090    16.32%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

RBS CAPITAL MARKETS CORP FBO

EDWARD SANDERS

DOUGLAS J SANDERS

JT TEN/WROS

2218 RICHARDSON DR

CHARLOTTE NC 28211-3265

   14,212.1620    12.20%

 

225


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

LILLIAN G SHOAF

830 METAIRIE LN

WINSTON SALEM NC 27104-3319

   9,747.6860    8.37%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

JASON LAMBERTH

CAROL LAMBERTH

PO BOX 24

STATESVILLE NC 28687-0024

   8,275.3300    7.10%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

101 MONTGOMERY ST

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94101-4151

   8,231.0200    7.07%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

KATE R HOOTS

1372 HARRIS AVE

NEWTON CA 28658-1611

   6,643.0310    5.70%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

CAROL LEE SMITH WOOD

P.O. BOX 313

HAW RIVER NC 27258-0313

   6,222.4570    5.34%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   145,918.7080    34.01%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

NFS LLC FEBO

CREIGHTON W SOSSOMON

BANK OF AMERICA COLLATERAL

P.O. BOX 9

HIGHLANDS NC 28741-0009

   28,307.1610    6.60%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   15,372,334.8690    91.85%

 

226


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   5,600,044.3410    18.66%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   160,515.4320    18.20%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   4,926,570.2190    38.23%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL

MARKETS, INC

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   890,814.6430    6.91%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,894,327.6870    89.35%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class Y

  

CLISE PROPERTIES INC

1700 7TH AVE STE 1800

SEATTLE WA 98101-1312

   224,803.2240    10.60%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   145,294,168.8900    71.57%

 

227


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   10,051,809.7010    25.24%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   4,676,412.5930    11.74%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund-

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   6,954,9570    21.65%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

KEVIN W BARR

FRANCINE BARR

5235 DRYSTACK LN

GLEN ALLEN VA 23059-2532

   4,906.4600    15.27%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

DARRELL C REED

MAUREEN O REED

4681 SHELBURNE RD

RADFORD VA 24141-8057

   4,609.1020    14.35%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

SIDNEY MORRIS

3605 BERMUDA RUN DR

VALDOSTA GA 31605-1082

   3,505.4160    10.91%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,368,911.6830    47.51%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   258,752.2480    5.19%

 

228


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   159,654,192.8970    86.25%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   775,103.7670    32.40%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

INTERNET RESOURCE MANAGEMENT

BANK OF AMERICA NA COLLATERAL

P.O. BOX 1329

FORT MILL SC 29716-1329

   541,187.7690    22.63%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   58,892.8520    60.68%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   6,618.2480    6.82%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

SUE B JAMES EST TX SHEL TRUST

1129 WATERFRONT DR

MT PLEASANT SC 29464-7428

   5,355.4450    5.52%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

WELLS FARGO BANK NA FBO

HOPKINS M CRTA

P.O. BOX 1533

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55480-1533

   5,203.0760    5.36%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   5,040.7010    5.19%

 

229


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   367,785.4010    38.59%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

RAYMOND JAMES & ASSOC INC

FBO ANNIE LEE FAYSSOUX TTEE

203 PACOLET HWY

GAFFNEY SC 29340-2816

   72,740.5460    7.63%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   12,681,570.0070    89.93%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   575,686.5780    26.27%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   86,466.3060    24.94%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   292,987.2470    51.76%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   86,875,990.2020    79.37%

 

230


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

C HENRY JONES TTEE

C HENRY JONES REVOCLIVTRUST

7320 COLONY POINT RD

NORFOLK VA 23505-3300

   235,505.2150    5.11%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,795.6150    14.62%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

EDWARD P HAZARD JR

FRANCES H HAZARD

915 HOLLYWOOD DR

CHESAPEAKE VA 23320-4821

   8,324.7130    8.82%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

PETER BRUNK & DIANE BRUNK JT WROS

3501 CARDINAL LN

PORTSMOUTH VA 23703-3631

   7,391.2080    7.83%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING CORPORATION

MARTHA W STEERS TTEE

MARTHA W STEERS LIVING TRUST

5801 WILLIAMSBURG

LANDING DR

WILLIAMSBURG VA 23185-3778

   6,783.3320    7.19%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

NORMA F STUART

6809 DARBY LN

SPRINGFIELD VA 22150-2006

   5,537.5620    5.87%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   53,516.4800    17.68%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   23,109,999.8350    92.99%

 

231


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Corporate Bond Portfolio

Class A

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,030,991.0000    99.24%

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Class A

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   3,673,814.0810    86.12%

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Class A

  

STATE STREET BANK &

TRUST CO

AAF LIFEGOAL INCOME & GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   430,028.9370    10.08%

As of August 31, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “control person” (as that term is defined in the 1940 Act) of a Fund because it owns of record more than 25% of the outstanding shares of the Fund by virtue of its fiduciary roles with respect to its clients or otherwise, is shown below. A control person may be able to facilitate shareholder approval of proposals it approves and to impede shareholder approval of proposals it opposes. If a control person’s record ownership of a Fund’s outstanding shares exceeds 50%, then, for certain shareholder proposals, such control person may be able to approve, or prevent approval, of such proposals without regard to votes by other Fund shareholders.

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending February 28:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Fund

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,941,500.7370    31.83%

Columbia International Value Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   34,350,727.8690    28.74%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   51,769,526.9970    55.08%

 

232


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
     Percentage
of Fund
 

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core

Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     35,430,037.5880         86.95%   

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     501,403.7210         71.78

Columbia Marsico International

Opportunities Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     54,208,961.1110         50.44

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     68,401,274.4280         31.75

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     65,820,152.9370         56.22

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     1,088,418.8280         100.00

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     12,402,334.2720         36.40

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     30,772,153.5870         30.75

 

233


Table of Contents

 

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
     Percentage
of Fund
 

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     2,538,471.9340         56.38

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     20,402,583.1980         85.53

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     9,169,349.1900         77.87%   

Columbia High Income Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     53,986,303.5250         53.88%   

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth

Portfolio

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     23,278,951.3000         43.93%   

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     15,638,592.1770         42.86%   
Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio   

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     5,645,598.1320         41.54%   

 

234


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Fund

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,036.212.8020    36.90%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   11,376,071.5190    75.19%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,650,697.2390    45.30%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   15,372,334.8690    73.61%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   147,188,496.5770    59.13%

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond

Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   159,654,192.8970    69.43%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,681,570.0070    72.28%

 

235


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Fund

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS, TX 75202-3908

   86,875,990.2020    77.18%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   23,109,999.8350    77.39%

Corporate Bond Portfolio

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,030,991.0000    99.24%

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   3,673,814.0810    86.12%

Bank of America, N.A. is a national banking association organized under the laws of the United States, 101 South Tryon Street, Charlotte, North Carolina 28255. Bank of America Corporation, a publicly-traded financial services corporation, is the ultimate parent company of Bank of America, N.A.

FIM Funding, Inc. is a non-depository credit institution organized under the laws of the United States, 401 North Tryon Street, Charlotte, North Carolina 28202. Bank of America Corporation is the ultimate parent company of FIM Funding, Inc.

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated is a registered broker-dealer organized under the laws of the United States, One Bryant Park, New York, New York 10036. Bank of America Corporation is the ultimate parent company of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated.

 

236


Table of Contents

 

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In June 2004, an action captioned John E. Gallus et al. v. American Express Financial Corp. and American Express Financial Advisors Inc., was filed in the United States District Court for the District of Arizona. The plaintiffs allege that they are investors in several American Express Company (now known as RiverSource) mutual funds and they purport to bring the action derivatively on behalf of those funds under the 1940 Act. The plaintiffs allege that fees allegedly paid to the defendants by the funds for investment advisory and administrative services are excessive. The plaintiffs seek remedies including restitution and rescission of investment advisory and distribution agreements. The plaintiffs voluntarily agreed to transfer this case to the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota (the District Court). In response to defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint, the District Court dismissed one of plaintiffs’ four claims and granted plaintiffs limited discovery. Defendants moved for summary judgment in April 2007. Summary judgment was granted in the defendants’ favor on July 9, 2007. The plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal with the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals (the Eighth Circuit) on August 8, 2007. On April 8, 2009, the Eighth Circuit reversed summary judgment and remanded to the District Court for further proceedings. On August 6, 2009, defendants filed a writ of certiorari with the U.S. Supreme Court (the Supreme Court), asking the Supreme Court to stay the District Court proceedings while the Supreme Court considered and ruled in a case captioned Jones v. Harris Associates, which involved issues of law similar to those presented in the Gallus case. On March 30, 2010, the Supreme Court issued its ruling in Jones v. Harris Associates, and on April 5, 2010, the Supreme Court vacated the Eighth Circuit’s decision in the Gallus case and remanded the case to the Eighth Circuit for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates. On June 4, 2010, the Eighth Circuit remanded the Gallus case to the District Court for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates.

In December 2005, without admitting or denying the allegations, American Express Financial Corporation (AEFC, which is now known as Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (Ameriprise Financial)), entered into settlement agreements with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and Minnesota Department of Commerce (MDOC) related to market timing activities. As a result, AEFC was censured and ordered to cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of certain provisions of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, the 1940 Act, and various Minnesota laws. AEFC agreed to pay disgorgement of $10 million and civil money penalties of $7 million. AEFC also agreed to retain an independent distribution consultant to assist in developing a plan for distribution of all disgorgement and civil penalties ordered by the SEC in accordance with various undertakings detailed at http://www.sec.gov/litigation/admin/ia-2451.pdf. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have cooperated with the SEC and the MDOC in these legal proceedings, and have made regular reports to the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds’ Boards of Directors/Trustees.

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions, and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that the Funds are not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial nor any of its affiliates are the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds. Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the SEC on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

There can be no assurance that these matters, or the adverse publicity associated with them, will not result in increased fund redemptions, reduced sale of fund shares or other adverse consequences to the Funds. Further, although we believe proceedings are not likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds, these proceedings are subject to uncertainties and, as such, we are unable to estimate the possible loss or range of loss that may result. An adverse outcome in one or more of these proceedings could result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties or other relief that could have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations of Ameriprise Financial.

 

237


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A — DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

This Appendix summarizes the various descriptions of securities ratings applicable to securities purchased by the Columbia Funds. Please refer to a Fund’s prospectus and statement of additional information to determine whether that Fund may invest in securities that have ratings described in this Appendix.

STANDARD & POOR’S (S&P)

Bonds

The following summarizes the ratings used by S&P for bonds. The ratings AAA, AA, A and BBB denote investment grade securities.

AAA bonds have the highest rating assigned by S&P and are considered to have an extremely strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

AA bonds are considered to have a very strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, and they differ from AAA only in small degree.

A bonds are considered to have a strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher rated categories.

BBB bonds are considered to have an adequate capacity to pay interest and repay principal. Whereas they normally exhibit adequate protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity to pay interest and repay principal than for bonds in the A category.

BB, B, CCC, CC and C bonds are considered to have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation. BB indicates the lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree. While such debt will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or large exposures to adverse conditions.

BB bonds are considered to have less near-term vulnerability to default than other speculative issues. However, they face major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments. The BB rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BBB – rating.

B bonds are considered to have a greater vulnerability to default but currently have the capacity to meet interest payments and principal repayments. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to pay interest and repay principal. The B rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BB or BB – rating.

CCC bonds are considered to have a currently identifiable vulnerability to default, and are dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions to meet timely payment of interest and repayment of principal. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the bonds are not likely to have the capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The CCC rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied B or B – rating.

CC rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC rating.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

C rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC – debt rating. The C rating may be used to cover a situation, for example, where a bankruptcy petition has been filed, but debt service payments are continued.

CI rating is reserved for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

D bonds are in payment default. The D rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments are not made on the date due even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made during such grace period. The D rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.

Plus (+) or minus (-): The ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus or minus sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

Municipal Notes

SP-1. Notes rated SP-1 are considered to have very strong or strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designated as SP-1+.

SP-2. Notes rated SP-2 are considered to have satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest.

Notes due in three years or less normally receive a note rating. Notes maturing beyond three years normally receive a bond rating, although the following criteria are used in making that assessment:

Amortization schedule (the larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely the issue will be rated as a note).

Source of payment (the more dependent the issue is on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it will be rated as a note).

Commercial Paper

A. Issues assigned this highest rating are regarded as having the greatest capacity for timely payment. Issues in this category are further refined with the designations 1, 2, and 3 to indicate the relative degree of safety.

A-1. Issues assigned to this rating are considered to have overwhelming or very strong capacity for timely payment. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designed A-1+.

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. (MOODY’S)

Municipal Bonds

Aaa bonds are considered to be of the best quality. They are considered to have the smallest degree of investment risk and are generally referred to as “gilt edge”. Interest payments are protected by a large or by an exceptionally stable margin and principal is secure. While various protective elements are likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair a fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Aa bonds are considered to be of high quality by all standards. Together with Aaa bonds they comprise what are generally known as high-grade bonds. They are rated lower than the best bonds because margins of protection may not be as large in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective elements may be of greater amplitude or there may be other elements present which make the long-term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

 

A-2


Table of Contents

 

Those bonds in the Aa through B groups that Moody’s believes possess the strongest investment attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1, A1 or Baa1.

A bonds are considered to possess many favorable investment attributes and are to be considered to be upper-medium-grade obligations. Factors giving security to principal and interest are considered adequate, but elements may be present that suggest a susceptibility to impairment at some time in the future.

Baa bonds are considered to be medium grade obligations: they are neither highly protected nor poorly secured. Interest payments and principal security appear adequate for the present but certain protective elements may be lacking or may be characteristically unreliable over any great period of time. Such bonds lack outstanding investment characteristics and, in fact, have speculative characteristics as well.

Ba bonds are considered to have speculative elements: their future cannot be considered as well secured. Often, the protection of interest and principal payments may be very moderate and thereby not well safeguarded during both good and bad times in the future. Uncertainty of position characterizes bonds in this grade.

B bonds are considered generally to lack characteristics of a desirable investment. Assurance of interest and principal payments or of maintenance of other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Caa bonds are considered to be of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Ca bonds are considered to represent obligations that are speculative in a high degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

C bonds are the lowest rated class of bonds and issues so rated are considered to have extremely poor prospects of ever attaining any real investment standing.

Conditional Ratings. Bonds for which the security depends upon the completion of some act or the fulfillment of some condition are rated conditionally. These are bonds secured by (a) earnings of projects under construction, (b) earnings of projects unseasoned in operating experience, (c) rentals which begin when facilities are completed, or (d) payments to which some other limiting conditions attach. Parenthetical rating denotes probable credit stature upon completion of construction or elimination of basis of condition.

Corporate Bonds

The description of the applicable rating symbols (Aaa, Aa, A, Baa, etc.) and their meanings is identical to that of the Municipal Bond ratings as set forth above, except for the numerical modifiers. Moody’s applies numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 in the Aa and A classifications of its corporate bond rating system. The modifier 1 indicates that the security ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a midrange ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates that the issuer ranks in the lower end of its generic rating category.

Municipal Notes

MIG 1. This designation denotes best quality. There is present strong protection by established cash flows, superior liquidity support or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.

MIG 2. This designation denotes high quality. Margins of protection are ample although not so large as in the preceding group.

 

A-3


Table of Contents

 

MIG 3. This designation denotes favorable quality. All security elements are accounted for, but there is lacking the undeniable strength of the preceding grades. Liquidity and cash flow protection may be narrow and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.

Commercial Paper

Moody’s employs the following three designations, all judged to be investment grade, to indicate the relative repayment capacity of rated issuers:

Prime-1 Highest Quality

Prime-2 Higher Quality

Prime-3 High Quality

If an issuer represents to Moody’s that its commercial paper obligations are supported by the credit of another entity or entities, Moody’s, in assigning ratings to such issuers, evaluates the financial strength of the indicated affiliated corporations, commercial banks, insurance companies, foreign governments, or other entities, but only as one factor in the total rating assessment.

FITCH, INC. (FITCH)

Long-Term Debt

Investment Grade Bond Ratings

AAA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of the highest credit quality. The obligor has an exceptionally strong ability to pay interest and/or dividends and repay principal, which is unlikely to be affected by reasonably foreseeable events.

AA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of very high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is very strong, although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA. Because bonds rated in the AAA and AA categories are not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable future developments, short-term debt of these issuers is generally rated F-1+.

A bonds are considered to be investment grade and of high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered to be strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances than debt securities with higher ratings.

BBB bonds are considered to be investment grade and of satisfactory credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest or dividends and repay principal is considered to be adequate. Adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances, however, are more likely to have adverse impact on these securities and, therefore, impair timely payment. The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall below investment grade is higher than for securities with higher ratings.

Speculative Grade Bond Ratings

BB bonds are considered speculative. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes. However, business and financial alternatives can be identified, which could assist the obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B bonds are considered highly speculative. While securities in this class are currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely payment of principal and interest reflects the obligor’s limited margin of safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the life of the issue.

 

A-4


Table of Contents

 

CCC bonds are considered to have certain identifiable characteristics that, if not remedied, may lead to default. The ability to meet obligations requires an advantageous business and economic environment.

CC bonds are considered to be minimally protected. Default in payment of interest and/or principal seems probable over time.

C bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments. Such securities are extremely speculative and should be valued on the basis of their ultimate recovery value in liquidation or reorganization of the obligor. DDD represents the highest potential for recovery on these securities and D represents the lowest potential for recovery.

Plus (+) or minus (-): Plus or minus signs are used to show relative standing within the major rating categories. Plus and minus signs, however, are not used in the DDD, DD, or D categories.

Short-Term Debt

Fitch’s short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand or have original maturities of up to three years, including commercial paper, certificates of deposit, medium-term notes, and investment notes.

F-1+ obligations have exceptionally strong credit quality and are considered to have the strongest degree of assurance for timely payment.

F-1 obligations are considered to reflect an assurance of timely payment only slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2 obligations are considered to have good credit quality. Securities in this class have a satisfactory degree of assurance for timely payment, but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned F-1+ and F-1 ratings.

F-3 obligations are considered to have characteristics suggesting that the degree of assurance for timely payment is adequate; however, near-term adverse changes could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a minimal degree of assurance for timely payment and to be vulnerable to near-term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions.

B obligations are considered to have a minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments and a susceptibility to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

C rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a high default risk and whose capacity for meeting financial commitments is solely reliant upon a sustained, favorable business and economic environment.

D obligations are in actual or imminent payment default.

 

A-5


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B — PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT INVESTMENT ADVISERS, LLC

PROXY VOTING POLICY FOR LEGACY COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT CLIENTS

EFFECTIVE MAY 1, 2010

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (CMIA) has adopted the attached Proxy Voting Policy for purposes of voting proxies of securities held in certain client accounts1, with the following changes:

 

   

References to Columbia Management Advisors, LLC and CMA are deemed to be references to Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC; and

 

   

References to Bank of America Corporation and BAC are deemed to be references to Ameriprise Financial, Inc.

In addition, the text of footnote 1 in the Proxy Voting Policy is hereby deleted and replaced with the following:

Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the corporate parent of Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, and all of its numerous affiliates own, operate and have interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between Ameriprise Financial, Inc. or its affiliates and those of clients advised by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. For example, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. and its affiliates may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

1 On April 30, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of CMIA, acquired from Bank of America, N.A. a portion of the asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC, the parent company of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”). In connection with this transaction, CMIA became the investment adviser of certain client accounts previously advised by CMA. CMIA will apply CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy to certain of these and other client accounts.

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) Proxy Voting Policy

 

Last Review Date:

   April 2010
Applicable Regulatory Authority:   

Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940

Form N-PX

ERISA Department of Labor Bulletin 08-2

Institutional Shareholder Services, Inc. (SEC No Action Letter dated September 15, 2004)

Explanation/Summary of Regulatory Requirements

An investment adviser that exercises voting authority over clients’ proxies must adopt written policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that those proxies are voted in the best economic interests of clients. An adviser’s policies and procedures must address how the adviser resolves material conflicts of interest between its interests and those of its clients. An investment adviser must comply with certain record keeping and disclosure requirements with respect to its proxy voting responsibilities. In addition, an investment adviser to Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) accounts has an affirmative obligation to vote proxies for an ERISA account, unless the client expressly retains proxy voting authority.

Policy Summary

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) has adopted and implemented the following policy, which it believes is reasonably designed to: (1) ensure that proxies are voted in the best economic interest of clients; and (2) address material conflicts of interest that may arise. This policy applies primarily to the Global Wealth and Investment Management (“GWIM”) Investment Operations Group, the Investment groups (particularly, Equity and Chief Investment Officer’s Office), as well as to Compliance Risk Management (“CRM”) and Legal. CRM and Business groups to which this policy directly applies must adopt written procedures to implement this Policy.

Policy

All proxies regarding client securities for which CMA has authority to vote will, unless CMA determines in accordance with policies stated below to refrain from voting, be voted in a manner considered by CMA to be in the best interest of CMA’s clients without regard to any resulting benefit or detriment to CMA, its associates, or its affiliates. The best interest of clients is defined for this purpose as the interest of enhancing or protecting the economic value of client accounts, considered as a group rather than individually, as CMA determines in its sole and absolute discretion. In the event a client believes that its other interests require a different vote, CMA will vote as the client clearly instructs, provided CMA receives such instructions in time to act accordingly. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential. Therefore, the information may be shared on a need to know basis only, including within CMA and with CMA affiliates. Advisory clients, including mutual funds’ and other funds’ boards, may obtain information on how their proxies were voted by CMA. However, CMA will not selectively disclose its investment company clients’ proxy voting records to third parties. Rather, the investment company clients’ proxy records will be disclosed to shareholders by publicly-available annual filings for 12-month periods ending each year on June 30th on Form N-PX.

CMA endeavors to vote, in accordance with this Policy, all proxies of which it becomes aware prior to the vote deadline date, subject to certain general exceptions described below.

CMA seeks to avoid the occurrence of actual or apparent material conflicts of interest in the proxy voting process by voting in accordance with predetermined voting guidelines and observing other procedures that are intended to prevent where practicable and manage conflicts of interest (refer to Conflicts of Interest section below). CMA’s proxy voting policy and practices are summarized in its Form ADV. Additionally, CMA will provide clients with a copy of its policies, as they may be updated from time to time, upon request.

 

B-2


Table of Contents

 

Means of Achieving Compliance

The Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations is primarily responsible for overseeing the day-to-day operations of the proxy voting process. The Proxy Group’s monitoring will take into account the following elements: (1) periodic review of the proxy vendor’s votes to ensure that the proxy vendor is accurately voting consistent with CMA’s Voting Guidelines; and (2) review of the Columbia Funds’ fund website to ensure that annual proxy voting reports are posted in a timely and accurate manner. CMA has established a Proxy Committee which is responsible for overseeing the proxy voting process.

The specific responsibilities of the Proxy Committee and scope of its oversight are described in the Proxy Committee’s charter.

CMA’S INVESTMENT ASSOCIATES’ RESPONSIBILITIES

Under CMA’s Voting Guidelines, certain matters must be determined on a case-by-case basis. In general, the Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations will refer these matters first to the relevant CMA research analyst after first confirming that the proxy matter does not present a potential conflict to CMA. If there is not a research analyst assigned to the particular security, the matter will be referred to the appropriate portfolio manager.

In considering a particular proxy matter, the research analyst or portfolio manager must vote in the clients’ best interest as defined above. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential information. Therefore, research analysts and portfolio managers generally must not discuss proxy votes with any person outside of CMA and within CMA except on a need to know basis only.

Research analysts and portfolio managers must discharge their responsibilities consistent with the obligations set forth below (refer to Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures). A research analyst or portfolio manager must disclose in writing any inappropriate attempt to influence their recommendation or any other personal interest that they have with the issuer (see Appendix B – Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form). For each Proxy Referral (defined below), the research analyst or portfolio manager is responsible for memorializing their recommendation on the Proxy Voting Recommendation Form (see Appendix C) and communicating their recommendation to the Proxy Group.

Research analysts and portfolio managers should seek advice from CRM or Legal with respect to any questions that they have regarding personal conflicts of interests, communications regarding proxies, or other related matters.

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

For purposes of this policy, a material conflict of interest is a relationship or activity engaged in by CMA, a CMA affiliate1, or a CMA associate that creates an incentive (or appearance thereof) to favor the interests of CMA, the affiliate, or associate, rather than the clients’ interests. However, a material conflict of interest is not automatically created when there is a relationship or activity engaged in by a CMA affiliate, but there is a possibility that a CMA affiliate could cause a conflict. CMA may have a conflict of interest if either CMA has a significant business relationship with a company that is soliciting a proxy, or if a CMA associate involved in the proxy voting decision-making process has a significant personal or family relationship with the particular

 

1 Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”), the ultimate corporate parent of CMA, Bank of America, N.A. and all of their numerous affiliates owns, operates and has interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between BAC or its affiliates and those of CMA-advised clients. For example, the commercial and investment banking business lines may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with CMA’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

B-3


Table of Contents

company. A conflict of interest is considered to be “material” to the extent that a reasonable person could expect the conflict to influence CMA’s decision on the particular vote at issue. In all cases where there is deemed to be a material conflict of interest, CMA will seek to resolve said conflict in the clients’ best interests.

For those proxy proposals that: (1) are not addressed by CMA’s proxy voting guidelines; (2) the guidelines specify the issue must be evaluated and determined on a case-by-case basis; or (3) a CMA investment associate believes that an exception to the guidelines may be in the best economic interest of CMA’s clients (collectively, “Proxy Referrals”), CMA may vote the proxy, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures set forth below.

In the case of Proxy Referrals, CRM identifies companies with which CMA has a significant business relationships and Proxy Referrals of such companies will be voted consistent with CMA’s conflicts management procedures described below. For Proxy Referrals that do not involve companies with which CMA has a significant business relationship the relevant CMA investment personnel (i.e. research analyst, portfolio manager, members of Proxy Committee) involved in the particular Proxy Referral must report any personal conflict of interest circumstances (e.g., relationships with nominees for directorship, members of an issuer’s or dissident’s management or otherwise, unusual communications with parties outside the investment organization concerning a proxy matter) to Columbia Management’s Conflicts of Interest Officer in writing (see Appendix B). In the event any member of the Proxy Committee has a conflict of interest regarding a given matter, he or she will similarly disclose the circumstance and abstain from participating in the Committee’s determination of whether and/or how to vote in the matter.

If the Proxy Committee, the Chairperson of the Proxy Committee, or the Conflicts Officer determines that a proxy matter presents a material conflict of interest, or a material conflict of interest is otherwise determined to exist through the application of this Policy, CMA will invoke one or more of the following conflict management procedures:

 

   

Causing the proxies to be voted in accordance with the recommendations of an independent third party (which generally will be CMA’s proxy voting agent);

 

   

Causing the proxies to be delegated to a qualified, independent third party, which may include CMA’s proxy voting agent; or

 

   

In unusual cases, with the Client’s consent and upon ample notice, forwarding the proxies to CMA’s clients so that they may vote the proxies directly.

Affiliate Investment Companies and Public Companies

CMA considers (1) proxies solicited by open-end and closed-end investment companies for which CMA or an affiliate serves as an investment adviser or principal underwriter; and (2) proxies solicited by Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”) or other public companies within the BAC organization to present a material conflict of interest for CMA. Consequently, the proxies of such affiliates will be voted following one of the conflict management practices discussed above.

Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures

In certain circumstances, CMA follows the proxy guidelines and uses other research services provided by the proxy vendor or another independent third party. CMA reviews its proxy vendor’s conflicts of interest procedures as part of its oversight of the proxy vendor’s services.

CMA and other BAC affiliates have adopted various other policies and procedures that help reinforce this Policy. Please see any associated documents.

Ownership Limits – Delegation of Proxy Voting to an Independent Third Party

From time to time, CMA may face regulatory or compliance limits on the types or amounts of voting securities that it may purchase or hold for client accounts. Among other limits, federal, state, foreign regulatory restrictions, or company-specific ownership limits may restrict the total percentage of an issuer’s voting securities that CMA can hold for clients (collectively, “Ownership Limits”).

 

B-4


Table of Contents

 

The regulations or company-specific documents governing a number of these Ownership Limits often focus upon holdings in voting securities. As a result, in limited circumstances in order to comply with such Ownership Limits and/or internal policies designed to comply with such limits, CMA may delegate proxy voting in certain issuers to a qualified, independent third party, who may be CMA’s proxy voting agent.

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

A. CMA’s Proxy Voting Guidelines – General Practices.

The Proxy Committee has adopted the guidelines for voting proxies specified in Appendix A of this policy. CMA uses an independent, third-party proxy vendor to implement its proxy voting process as CMA’s proxy voting agent. In general, whenever a vote is solicited, the proxy vendor will execute the vote according to CMA’s Voting Guidelines.

B. Ability to Vote Proxies Other than as Provided by Voting Guidelines.

A Portfolio Manager or other party involved with a client’s account may conclude that the best interest of the firm’s client, as defined above, requires that a proxy be voted in a manner that differs from the predetermined proxy Voting Guidelines. In this situation, he or she will request in writing that the Proxy Committee consider voting the proxy other than according to such Guidelines and provide information as the Proxy Committee may request. The Proxy Committee may consider the matter, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures discussed above.

C. Other Proxy Matters

For the following categories, proxies will be voted as stated below:

1. New Proposals. For certain new proposals that are expected to be proposed to shareholders of multiple companies, the Proxy Committee may develop a Voting Guideline which will be incorporated into this Policy.

2. Accounts Adhering to Taft Hartley Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to Taft Hartley principles will be voted according to the Taft Hartley Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor.

3. Accounts Adhering to Socially Responsible Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to socially responsible principles will be voted according to the Socially Responsible Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client.

4. Proxies of International Issuers. In general, CMA will refrain from voting securities in cases where international issuers impose share blocking restrictions. However, in the exceptional circumstances that CMA determines that it would be appropriate to vote such securities, all proposals for these securities will be voted only on the specific instruction of the Proxy Committee and to the extent practicable in accordance with the Voting Guidelines set forth in this Policy. Additionally, proxies will typically not be voted in markets where powers of attorney are required to be executed in order to vote shares.

5. Proxy Referrals for Passive Index Accounts. Proxy Referrals for a security that is held only within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and not in any other account within CMA, shall be voted according to the guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client. However, if a security is held within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and within another CMA-managed account (including without limitation an account actively managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group), all proposals, including Proxy Referrals, will be voted in accordance with the Voting Guidelines, subject to the other provisions of this Policy.

6. Proxy Voting for Securities on Loan. CMA generally votes in cases where shares have been loaned from actively managed Columbia Funds as long as the shares have been recalled in a timely manner. However, CMA generally does not vote shares that have been loaned from passively managed Columbia Index Funds. Other CMA clients may have their own stock loan programs and may or may not recall their shares for proxy voting.

 

B-5


Table of Contents

 

Supervision

Managers and supervisory personnel are responsible for ensuring that their associates understand and follow this policy and any applicable procedures adopted by the business group to implement the policy. The Proxy Committee has ultimate responsibility for the implementation of this Policy.

Escalation

With the exception of conflicts of interest-related matters, issues arising under this policy should be escalated to the Proxy Committee. Issues involving potential or actual conflicts of interest should be promptly communicated to the Columbia Management Conflicts Officer.

Monitoring/Oversight

CRM and/or Corporate Internal Audit Group perform periodic reviews and assessments of various lines of businesses, including a review of Columbia Management’s compliance with the Proxy Voting Policy.

Recordkeeping

CMA will create and maintain records of each investment company’s proxy record for 12-month periods ended June 30th. CMA will compile the following information for each matter relating to a portfolio security considered at any shareholder meeting during the period covered by the annual report and for which CMA was entitled to vote:

 

   

The name of the issuer of the security;

 

   

The exchange ticker symbol of the portfolio security (if symbol is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The Council on Uniform Securities Identification Procedures number for the portfolio security (if number is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The shareholder meeting date;

 

   

A brief identification of the matter voted on;

 

   

Whether the matter was proposed by the issuer or by a security holder;

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote on the matter;

 

   

How the company cast its vote (e.g., for or against proposal, or abstain; for or withhold regarding the election of directors); and

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote for or against management.

Business groups and support partners are responsible for maintaining all records necessary to evidence compliance with this policy. The records must be properly maintained and readily accessible in order to evidence compliance with this policy.

 

B-6


Table of Contents

 

These records include:

 

Document

  

Responsible Party

Proxy Committee Meeting Minutes and Related Materials    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Proxy Vote Recommendation Form and Supporting Materials of Investment Management Personnel Concerning Proxy Decisions and Recommendations (or any other document created by CMA that was material to making a voting decision or that memorializes the basis for the voting decision)    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Conflicts of Interest Review Documentation, including Conflicts of Interest Forms    Compliance Risk Management
Client Communications Regarding Proxy Matters    Client Service Group
Copy of Each Applicable Proxy Statement Unless it has been Filed with the SEC and may be Obtained from the SEC’s EDGAR System    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations

Records should be retained for a period of not less than six years plus the current year. Records must be retained in an appropriate office of CM for the first three years.

 

B-7


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A – CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy

CMA’S VOTING GUIDELINES

A. The Proxy Committee has adopted the following guidelines for voting proxies:

1. Matters Relating to the Board of Directors/Corporate Governance

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals for the election of directors or for an increase or decrease in the number of directors, provided that no more than one-third of the Board of Directors would, presently or at any time during the previous three-year period, be from management.

However, CMA generally will WITHHOLD votes from pertinent director nominees if:

 

  (i) the board as proposed to be constituted would have more than one-third of its members from management;

 

  (ii) the board does not have audit, nominating, and compensation committees composed solely of directors who qualify as being regarded as “independent,” i.e. having no material relationship, directly or indirectly, with the Company, as CMA’s proxy voting agent may determine (subject to the Proxy Committee’s contrary determination of independence or non-independence);

 

  (iii) the nominee, as a member of the audit committee, permitted the company to incur excessive non-audit fees (as defined below regarding other business matters — ratification of the appointment of auditors);

 

  (iv) a director serves on more than six public company boards;

 

  (v) the CEO serves on more than two public company boards other than the company’s board; or

 

  (vi) CMA generally will vote AGAINST Director nominee of a company who is chief executive officer of another company on whose board the company’s chief executive officer sits (i.e. interlocking executives).

One a CASE-BY-CASE basis, CMA may WITHHOLD votes for a director nominee who has failed to observe good corporate governance practices or, through specific corporate action or inaction (e.g. failing to implement policies for which a majority of shareholders has previously cast votes in favor; served voted for the adoption of a poison pill without approval of shareholders), has demonstrated a disregard for the interests of shareholders.

 

   

Proposals requesting that the board audit, compensation and/or nominating committee be composed solely of independent directors. The Audit Committee must satisfy the independence and experience requirements established by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and the New York Stock Exchange, or appropriate local requirements for foreign securities. At least one member of the Audit Committee must qualify as a “financial expert” in accordance with SEC rules.

 

   

Proposals to declassify a board, absent special circumstances that would indicate that shareholder interests are better served by a classified board structure.

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to separate the role of Chairman of the Board and CEO.

 

   

Proposals that grant or restore shareholder ability to remove directors with or without cause.

 

   

Proposals to permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that encourage directors to own a minimum amount of company stock.

 

   

Proposals to provide or to restore shareholder appraisal rights.

 

   

Proposals for the company to adopt confidential voting.

 

B-8


Table of Contents

 

CMA will generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for majority voting thresholds for director elections unless the company has adopted formal corporate governance principles that present a meaningful alternative to the majority voting standard and/or provides an adequate response to both new nominees as well as incumbent nominees who fail to receive a majority of votes cast.

CMA will generally vote FOR 162(m) bonus plans unless the Proxy Administrator recommends voting against a specific plan, in which case CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to classify boards, absent special circumstances indicating that shareholder interests would be better served by a classified board structure.

 

   

Proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board without shareholder approval.

 

   

Proposals that provide directors may be removed only by supermajority vote.

 

   

Proposals which allow more than one vote per share in the election of directors.

 

   

Proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that mandate a minimum amount of company stock that directors must own.

 

   

Proposals to limit the tenure of non-management directors.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

In contested elections of directors. Proposals to adopt or eliminate cumulative voting.

 

   

CMA generally will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on board approved proposals relating to corporate governance. Such proposals include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Reimbursement of proxy solicitation expenses taking into consideration whether or not CMA was in favor of the dissidents.

 

   

Proxy contest advance notice. CMA generally will vote FOR proposals that allow shareholders to submit proposals as close to the meeting date as possible while allowing for sufficient time for Company response, SEC review, and analysis by other shareholders.

 

   

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis to indemnify directors and officers, and AGAINST proposals to indemnify external auditors.

 

   

CMA will vote FOR the indemnification of internal auditors, unless the costs associated with the approval are not disclosed.

2. Compensation

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

CMA generally will vote FOR management sponsored compensation plans (such as bonus plans, incentive plans, stock option plans, pension and retirement benefits, stock purchase plans or thrift plans) if they are consistent with industry and country standards.

 

   

Proposals requiring that executive severance arrangements be submitted for shareholder ratification.

 

   

Proposals asking a company to expense stock options.

 

   

Proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

 

   

Employee stock purchase plans that have the following features: (i) the shares purchased under the plan are acquired for no less than 85% of their market value, (ii) the offering period under the plan is 27 months or less, and (iii) dilution is 10% or less.

 

B-9


Table of Contents

 

   

Shareholder proposals to adopt a non-binding advisory vote on Executive Compensation (“Say on Pay”).

 

   

CMA recognizes that individual compensation committees are in the best position to determine the optimal design of share based plans. However, CMA generally prefers a greater use of restricted stock in place of stock options due to the greater uncertainty involved with the valuation of stock options at the time of issue.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Stock option plans that permit issuance of options with an exercise price below the stock’s current market price, or that permit replacing or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals to authorize the replacement or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals requesting that plan administrators have advance authority to amend the terms of a plan without detailed disclosure of the specific amendments. When sufficient details are provided on the amendments permitted by the advance authority, CMA will recommend on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

CMA generally is opposed to compensation plans that substantially dilute ownership interest in a company, provide participants with excessive awards, or have objectionable structural features. Specifically, for equity-based plans, if the proposed number of shares authorized for option programs (excluding authorized shares for expired options) exceeds 5% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years, or exceeds 1% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years (for directors only), CMA will vote on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. CMA requires that management provide substantial justification for the repricing of options.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals regarding approval of specific executive severance arrangements.

 

   

-Management proposals regarding “Say on Pay” (i.e. non-binding advisory vote on pay).

 

   

Proposals that involve awarding 50% or more of the equity shares of an equity-based compensation plan to the top five or fewer executives.

3. Capitalization

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to increase the authorized shares for stock dividends, stock splits (and reverse stock splits) or general issuance, unless proposed as an anti-takeover measure or a general issuance proposal increases the authorization by more than 30% without a clear need presented by the company. Proposals for reverse stock splits should include an overall reduction in authorization.

For companies recognizing preemptive rights for existing shareholders, CMA generally will vote FOR general issuance proposals that increase the authorized shares by more than 30%. CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all such proposals by companies that do not recognize preemptive rights for existing shareholders.

 

   

Proposals for the elimination of authorized but unissued shares or retirement of those shares purchased for sinking fund or treasury stock.

 

   

Proposals to institute/renew open market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

 

   

Proposals to reduce or change the par value of common stock, provided the number of shares is also changed in order to keep the capital unchanged.

 

B-10


Table of Contents

 

CMA will evaluate on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals regarding:

 

   

Management proposals that allow listed companies to de-list and terminate the registration of their common stock. CMA will determine whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by giving consideration to:

 

   

Whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly traded.

 

   

Cash-out value

 

   

Balanced interests of continuing vs. cashed-out shareholders

 

   

Market reaction to public announcement of transaction

4. Mergers, Restructurings and Other Transactions

CMA will review, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, business transactions such as mergers, acquisitions, reorganizations, liquidations, spinoffs, buyouts and sale of all or substantially all of a company’s assets.

5. Anti-Takeover Measures

CMA generally will vote AGAINST proposals intended largely to avoid acquisition prior to the occurrence of an actual event or to discourage acquisition by creating a cost constraint. With respect to the following measures, CMA generally will vote as follows:

Poison Pills

 

   

CMA votes FOR shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification.

 

   

CMA generally votes FOR shareholder proposals to eliminate a poison pill.

 

   

CMA generally votes AGAINST management proposals to ratify a poison pill.

 

Greenmail

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or to otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

Supermajority vote

 

   

CMA will vote AGAINST board-approved proposals to adopt anti-takeover measures such as supermajority voting provisions, issuance of blank check preferred stock, the creation of a separate class of stock with disparate voting rights and charter amendments adopting control share acquisition provisions.

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share acquisition statutes.

6. Other Business Matters

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Bylaw amendments giving holders of at least 25% of outstanding common stock the ability to call a special meeting of stockholders.

 

   

Board governance document amendments or other proposals which give the lead independent director the authority to call special meetings of the independent directors at any time.

 

B-11


Table of Contents

 

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to approve routine business matters such as changing the company’s name and procedural matters relating to the shareholder meeting such as approving the minutes of a prior meeting.

 

   

Proposals to ratify the appointment of auditors, unless any of the following apply in which case CMA will generally vote AGAINST the proposal:

 

   

Credible reason exists to question:

 

   

The auditor’s independence, as determined by applicable regulatory requirements.

 

   

The accuracy or reliability of the auditor’s opinion as to the company’s financial position.

 

   

Fees paid to the auditor or its affiliates for “non-audit” services exceeds 25% of the total fees paid for “audit,” “audit-related” and “tax compliance” and/or “tax return preparation” services, as disclosed in the company’s proxy materials.

 

   

Bylaw or charter changes that are of a housekeeping nature (e.g., updates or corrections).

 

   

Proposals to approve the annual reports and accounts provided the certifications required by the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 have been provided.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to eliminate the right of shareholders to act by written consent or call special meetings.

 

   

Proposals providing management with authority to adjourn an annual or special shareholder meeting absent compelling reasons, or to adopt, amend or repeal bylaws without shareholder approval, or to vote unmarked proxies in favor of management.

 

   

Shareholder proposals to change the date, time or location of the company’s annual meeting of shareholders.

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Authorization to transact other unidentified substantive (as opposed to procedural) business at a meeting.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals to change the location of the company’s state of incorporation. CMA considers whether financial benefits (e.g., reduced fees or taxes) likely to accrue to the company as a result of a reincorporation or other change of domicile outweigh any accompanying material diminution of shareholder rights.

 

   

Proposals on whether and how to vote on “bundled” or otherwise conditioned proposals, depending on the overall economic effects upon shareholders.

CMA generally will ABSTAIN from voting on shareholder proposals predominantly involving social, socio-economic, environmental, political or other similar matters on the basis that their impact on share value can rarely be anticipated with any high degree of confidence. CMA may, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, vote:

 

   

FOR proposals seeking inquiry and reporting with respect to, rather than cessation or affirmative implementation of, specific policies where the pertinent issue warrants separate communication to shareholders; and

 

   

FOR or AGAINST the latter sort of proposal in light of the relative benefits and detriments (e.g. distraction, costs, other burdens) to share value which may be expected to flow from passage of the proposal.

 

B-12


Table of Contents

 

7. Other Matters Relating to Foreign Issues

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Most stock (scrip) dividend proposals. CMA votes AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

 

   

Proposals to capitalize the company’s reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase the par value of shares.

 

   

Proposals to approve control and profit transfer agreements between a parent and its subsidiaries.

 

   

Management proposals seeking the discharge of management and supervisory board members, unless there is concern about the past actions of the company’s auditors/directors and/or legal action is being taken against the board by other shareholders.

 

   

Management proposals concerning allocation of income and the distribution of dividends, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

Proposals for the adoption of financing plans if they are in the best economic interests of shareholders.

CMA will generally vote FOR proposals to approve Directors’ Fees, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA will evaluate management proposals to approve protective preference shares for Netherlands located company-friendly foundations proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis and will only support resolutions if:

 

   

The supervisory board needs to approve an issuance of shares while the supervisory board is independent within the meaning of CMA’s categorization rules and the Dutch Corporate Governance Code.

 

   

No call/put option agreement exists between the company and the foundation.

 

   

There is a qualifying offer clause or there are annual management and supervisory board elections.

 

   

The issuance authority is for a maximum of 18 months.

 

   

The board of the company-friendly foundation is independent.

 

   

The company has disclosed under what circumstances it expects to make use of the possibility to issue preference shares.

 

   

There are no priority shares or other egregious protective or entrenchment tools.

 

   

The company releases its proxy circular, with details of the poison pill proposal, at least three weeks prior to the meeting.

 

   

Art 2:359c Civil Code of the legislative proposal has been implemented.

8. Investment Company Matters

Election of Directors:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the election of directors, considering the following factors:

 

   

Board structure

 

   

Attendance at board and committee meetings.

 

B-13


Table of Contents

 

CMA will WITHHOLD votes from directors who:

 

   

Attend less than 75 percent of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse for the absences. Valid reasons include illness or absence due to company business. Participation via telephone is acceptable. In addition, if the director missed only one meeting or one day’s meetings, votes should not be withheld even if such absence dropped the director’s attendance below 75 percent.

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal that is approved by a majority of shares outstanding;

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal this is approved by a majority of the votes cast for two consecutive years;

 

   

Are interested directors and sit on the audit or nominating committee; or

 

   

Are interested directors and the full board serves as the audit or nominating committee or the company does not have one of these committees.

Proxy Contests:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for proxy contests, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance relative to its peers

 

   

Market in which fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the pertinent issues (e.g., closed-end fund share market value discount to NAV)

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity and votes on related proposals

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents

 

   

Independence of incumbent directors; director nominees

 

   

Experience and skills of director nominees

 

   

Governance profile of the company

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund:

CMA will vote conversion proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance as a closed-end fund

 

   

Market in which the fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the discount

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals.

Investment Advisory Agreements:

CMA will vote investment advisory agreements on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Proposed and current fee schedules

 

   

Fund category/investment objective

 

   

Performance benchmarks

 

   

Share price performance as compared with peers

 

   

Resulting fees relative to peers

 

   

Assignments (where the adviser undergoes a change of control)

 

B-14


Table of Contents

 

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of new classes or series of shares.

Preferred Stock Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the authorization for or increase in the preferred shares, considering the following factors:

 

   

Stated specific financing purpose

 

   

Possible dilution for common shares

 

   

Whether the shares can be used for anti-takeover purposes

Policies Addressed by the Investment Company Act of 1940 (“1940 Act”):

CMA will vote proposals regarding adoption or changes of policies addressed by the 1940 Act on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Regulatory developments

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Current and potential risk

CMA generally will vote FOR these amendments as long as the proposed changes do not fundamentally alter the investment focus of the fund and do comply with current SEC interpretations.

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Non-fundamental Restriction:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fundamental restriction to a non-fundamental restriction, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fund’s target investments

 

   

Reasons given by the fund for the change

 

   

Projected impact of the change on the portfolio

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Non-fundamental:

CMA will vote AGAINST proposals to change a fund’s investment objective from fundamental to non-fundamental unless management acknowledges meaningful limitations upon its future requested ability to change the objective

Name Change Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s name, considering the following factors:

 

   

Political/economic changes in the target market

 

   

Consolidation in the target market

 

   

Current asset composition

 

B-15


Table of Contents

 

Change in Fund’s Subclassification:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s subclassification, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Risk of concentration

 

   

Consolidation in target industry

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis these proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Strategies employed to salvage the company

 

   

Past performance of the fund

 

   

Terms of the liquidation

Changes to the Charter Document:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change the charter document, considering the following factors:

 

   

The degree of change implied by the proposal

 

   

The efficiencies that could result

 

   

The state of incorporation; net effect on shareholder rights

 

   

Regulatory standards and implications

CMA will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals allowing the Board to impose, without shareholder approval, fees payable upon redemption of fund shares, provided imposition of such fees is likely to benefit long-term fund investors (e.g., by deterring market timing activity by other fund investors)

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to amend, without shareholder approval, the fund’s management agreement(s) with its investment adviser(s) or sub-advisers, provided the amendment is not required by applicable law (including the Investment Company Act of 1940) or interpretations thereunder to require such approval

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to:

 

   

Change, without shareholder approval the domicile of the fund

 

   

Adopt, without shareholder approval, material amendments of the fund’s declaration of trust or other organizational document

Changing the Domicile of a Fund:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reincorporate, considering the following factors:

 

   

Regulations of both states

 

   

Required fundamental policies of both states

 

   

The increased flexibility available

 

B-16


Table of Contents

 

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval:

CMA will vote FOR proposals to enable the Board or Investment Adviser to hire and terminate sub-advisers, without shareholder approval, in accordance with applicable rules or exemptive orders under the Investment Company Act of 1940

Distribution Agreements:

CMA will vote these proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fees charged to comparably sized funds with similar objectives

 

   

The proposed distributor’s reputation and past performance

 

   

The competitiveness of the fund in the industry

 

   

Terms of the agreement

Master-Feeder Structure:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of a master-feeder structure.

Mergers:

CMA will vote merger proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Resulting fee structure

 

   

Performance of both funds

 

   

Continuity of management personnel

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights

Shareholder Proposals to Establish Director Ownership Requirement:

CMA will generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a specific minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board. While CMA favors stockownership on the part of directors, the company should determine the appropriate ownership requirement.

Shareholder Proposals to Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses.

Shareholder Proposals to Terminate the Investment Adviser:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to terminate the investment adviser, considering the following factors:

 

   

Performance of the fund’s NAV

 

   

The fund’s history of shareholder relations

 

   

The performance of other funds under the adviser’s management

 

B-17


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B

Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form

Conflict Review Questionnaire for Proxy Voting Working Group Members and Other Individuals

Participating in the Proxy Voting Decision-Making Process.

Instructions: Please complete each of the questions. Please provide an explanation for any affirmative responses. Return the completed questionnaire to Columbia Management Conflicts of Interest Officer.

 

 

 

Issuer and Proxy Matter:      

 

 

 

 

  1. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any management personnel of the issuer1?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  2. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any person participating, supporting, opposing or otherwise connected with the particular proxy proposal (e.g., principals of the issuer; director nominees of issuer company; shareholder activists)?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  3. Have you discussed this particular proxy proposal with anyone outside of Columbia Management’s investment group2?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

 

  4. Are you aware of any other potential personal conflicts of interest not described above? Please detail below.

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

Name:      
Signed:      
Date:      

 

1 Personal investing in the issuer by you or a member of your immediate family does not require an affirmative response to this item.
2 Communications with issuer or solicitors in the regular course of business would not have to be disclosed on this form.

 

B-18


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C

CMA Proxy Vote Recommendation/Proxy Committee Request Form

 

Name of Investment Associate:      

 

Company Name:      

 

Overview of Proxy Vote and Meeting Date:      

 

 

 

Proxy Agenda Item(s)

 

Description of Item:      
 
(The above information will be pre-populated by the Proxy Department.)

 

Recommendation (FOR, AGAINST, ABSTAIN) including brief rationale:      

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Please attach any supporting information other than analysis or reports provided by the Proxy Department.

 

 

 

Signed

By signing, I am certifying that I either have no conflicts of interest-related information to report or have sent a completed “Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form” to Compliance Risk Management (Conflicts Officer).

 

 

Send Completed Forms to:

GWIM Investment Operations – Proxy Department

        or

In the case of Proxy Votes to be referred to the Proxy Committee, submit this form and materials to the Chair of the Proxy Committee

 

B-19


Table of Contents

 

MacKay Shields Proxy Voting Policy and Procedures

MacKay Shields LLC

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

1. Introduction

MacKay Shields LLC (“MacKay Shields” or the “Firm”), has adopted these “Proxy Voting Policy and Procedures” (the “Policy”) to ensure the Firm’s compliance with Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (the “Advisers Act”) and other applicable fiduciary obligations. The Policy applies to proxies relating to securities held by clients of MacKay Shields who have delegated the responsibility of voting proxies to the Firm. The Policy is designed to assist Firm employees in meeting their specific responsibilities in this area and to ensure that proxies are voted in the best interests of the Firm’s clients.

2. Statement of Policy

2.1 It is the policy of MacKay Shields that where the Firm has voting authority, all proxies are to be voted in the best interest of the client without regard to the interests of MacKay Shields or other related parties. Specifically, MacKay Shields shall not subordinate the interests of clients to unrelated objectives. MacKay Shields shall act with the care, skill, prudence and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims. For purposes of the Policy, the “best interests of clients” shall mean, unless otherwise specified by the client, the clients’ best economic interests over the long term — that is, the common interest that all MacKay Shields clients share in seeing the value of a common investment increase over time. It is further the policy of the Firm that complete and accurate disclosure concerning its proxy voting policies and procedures and proxy voting records as required by the Advisers Act, be made available to its clients.

2.2 When proxies with respect to securities held by clients of MacKay Shields have not been received by MacKay Shields or its proxy voting service provider, MacKay Shields will make reasonable efforts to obtain missing proxies. MacKay Shields is not responsible for voting proxies it or its proxy voting service provider does not receive.

2.3 MacKay Shields may choose not to vote proxies under the following circumstances:

 

   

If the effect on the client’s economic interests or the value of the portfolio holding is indeterminable or insignificant;

 

   

If the cost of voting the proxy outweighs the possible benefit; or

 

   

If a jurisdiction imposes share blocking restrictions which prevent the Firm from trading shares.

3. Use of Third Party Proxy Voting Service Provider

To discharge its responsibility, MacKay Shields has examined third-party services that assist in the researching and voting of proxies and the development of voting guidelines. After such review, the Firm has selected RiskMetrics Group (“RM”), to assist it in researching voting proposals, analyzing the financial implications of voting proposals and voting proxies. MacKay Shields utilizes the research and analytical services, operational implementation, administration, record-keeping and reporting services provided by RM.

4. Proxy Voting Guidelines

4.1 MacKay Shields has determined that, except as set forth in Sections 6 and 7, proxies for non-union clients who so specify will be voted in accordance with the voting recommendations contained in the applicable

 

B-20


Table of Contents

RM non-union domestic or global proxy voting guidelines, as in effect from time to time (“Non-Union Guidelines”). A summary of the current Non-Union Guidelines is attached as Exhibit A.

4.2 MacKay Shields has determined that, except as set forth in Sections 6 and 7, proxies for union or Taft-Hartley clients who so specify will be voted in accordance with the voting recommendations contained in the applicable RM Taft-Hartley domestic or global proxy voting guidelines, as in effect from time to time (“Union Guidelines”). A summary of the current Union Guidelines is attached as Exhibit B.

4.3 For purposes of the Policy, the Non-Union and Union Guidelines are collectively referred to as the Standard Guidelines.

4.4 A client may choose to use proxy voting guidelines different from the Standard Guidelines (“Custom Guidelines”). Any Custom Guidelines must be furnished by the client to MacKay Shields in writing.

4.5 In the event the Standard Guidelines or any client’s Custom Guidelines do not address how a proxy should be voted or state that the vote is to be determined on a “case-by-case” basis, the proxy will be voted in accordance with RM recommendations, subject to Section 6. In the event that RM has not made a recommendation, MacKay Shields will follow the procedure set forth in Section 7.

4.6 Notwithstanding the foregoing, MacKay Shields will vote a proxy with respect to a particular security held by a client in accordance with such client’s specific request even if it is in a manner inconsistent with the Standard Guidelines or the client’s Custom Guidelines, as the case may be. Any such specific requests must be furnished to MacKay Shields by the client in writing and must be received by MacKay on a timely basis for instructing RM how to cast the vote.

4.7 In order to avoid possible conflicts of interest, MacKay Shields votes proxies based on the Standard Guidelines or a client’s Custom Guidelines, as the case may be. However, it is recognized that the Firm’s portfolio management team has the ultimate responsibility for proxy voting.

4.8 For clients using the Standard Guidelines, the Firm will instruct RM to cast votes in accordance with the Standard Guidelines. For clients using Custom Guidelines, the Firm will provide RM with a copy of such Custom Guidelines and will instruct RM to cast votes in accordance with such Custom Guidelines. RM will cast votes in accordance with the Standard Guidelines or Custom Guidelines, as the case may be, unless instructed otherwise by MacKay Shields as set forth in Sections 6 and 7. Upon receipt of a specific request from a client pursuant to Section 4.6, the Firm will instruct RM to cast such client’s proxy in accordance with such request.

5. Client Account Set-up and Review

5.1 Initially, MacKay Shields must determine whether the client seeks to retain the responsibility of voting proxies, or seeks to delegate that responsibility to the Firm. The marketing or client service person responsible for setting up the account, in conjunction with MacKay’s Legal/Compliance Department, will have primary responsibility for making that determination. In its sole discretion, the Firm may decline to accept authority to vote a client’s proxies. Any such refusal shall be in writing.

5.2 If MacKay Shields has authority to vote a client’s proxies, the marketing or client service person responsible for setting up the account will ask the client to specify in writing (which may be by e-mail) whether the Firm should vote proxies in accordance with the Non-Union Guidelines, Union Guidelines or Custom Guidelines.

5.3 In most cases, the delegation of voting authority to MacKay Shields, and the Firm’s use of a third-party proxy voting service provider shall be memorialized in the client’s investment management agreement.

 

B-21


Table of Contents

 

5.4 MacKay Shields shall notify RM of new client accounts using such form as RM shall specify from time to time. Designated personnel within the Firm will be responsible for ensuring that each new client’s account for which the Firm has proxy voting authority is established on the appropriate systems and that each such account is properly coded for voting under the appropriate Non-Union Guidelines, Union Guidelines or Custom Guidelines, as the case may be.

6. Overriding Guidelines

A portfolio manager may propose that a particular proxy vote be cast in a manner different from the Standard Guidelines or a RM voting recommendation, or may propose an abstention from voting, if he/she believes that to do so, based on all facts and circumstances, is in the best interest of the Firm’s clients as a whole. Any portfolio manager who proposes to override the Standard Guidelines or a RM voting recommendation on a particular vote or to abstain from voting must complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form, which is set forth in Schedule C.

7. Referral of Voting Decision by RM to MacKay Shields

7.1 In the event that the Standard Guidelines or a client’s Custom Guidelines do not address how a proxy should be voted on a specific proposal for an issuer and RM has not made a recommendation as to how such proxy should be voted, RM will so advise MacKay Shields. In that event, the Legal/Compliance Department will request that the appropriate portfolio manager make a voting recommendation and complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form.

7.2 In the event that the Standard Guidelines or a client’s Custom Guidelines require a “case-by-case” determination on a particular proxy vote and RM has not made a recommendation as to how such proxy should be voted, RM will so advise MacKay Shields. In that event, the Legal/Compliance Department will request that the appropriate portfolio manager make a voting recommendation and complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form.

7.3 In the event that RM determines that a conflict of interest exists as a result of which RM is precluded from making a recommendation as to how a proxy should be voted on a specific proposal for an issuer, RM will so advise MacKay Shields. In that event, the Legal/Compliance Department will request that the appropriate portfolio manager make a voting recommendation and complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form.

8. Conflicts of Interest

8.1 The Firm’s portfolio managers may make proxy voting decisions in connection with (i) overriding the Standard Guidelines or an RM voting recommendation pursuant to Section 6, or (ii) deciding on a vote pursuant to Section 7. In such event, the portfolio managers have an affirmative duty to disclose any potential conflict of interest known to them that exists between the Firm and the client on whose behalf the proxy is to be voted (“Conflict”).

8.2. By way of example, Conflicts may exist in situations where the Firm is called to vote on a proxy involving an issuer or proponent of a proxy proposal regarding the issuer where MacKay Shields or an affiliated person of the Firm also:

 

   

Manages the issuer’s or proponent’s pension plan;

 

   

Administers the issuer’s or proponent’s employee benefit plan;

 

   

Provided brokerage, underwriting, insurance or banking services to the issuer or proponent; or

 

   

Manages money for an employee group.

 

B-22


Table of Contents

 

Additional Conflicts may exist, among others, if an executive of the Firm or its control affiliates is a close relative of, or has a personal or business relationship with:

 

   

An executive of the issuer or proponent;

 

   

A director of the issuer or proponent;

 

   

A person who is a candidate to be a director of the issuer;

 

   

A participant in the proxy contest; or

 

   

A proponent of a proxy proposal.

8.3 Whether a relationship creates a Conflict will depend on the facts and circumstances. Even if these parties do not attempt to influence the Firm with respect to voting, the value of the relationship to MacKay Shields or an affiliate can create a Conflict.

8.4 After a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form is completed pursuant to Sections 6 or 7, such Form, which elicits information as to whether a potential Conflict exists, must be submitted to the Legal/Compliance Department for review. If the Firm’s General Counsel (“GC”) or Chief Compliance Officer (“CCO”) determines that there is no potential Conflict, the GC or CCO or their designee may instruct RM to vote the proxy issue as set forth in the completed Form.

8.5 If the GC or CCO determines that there exists or may exist a Conflict, he or she will refer the issue to the Compliance Committee for consideration by convening (in person or via telephone) an emergency meeting of the Compliance Committee. For purposes of this Policy, a majority vote of those members present shall resolve any Conflict. The Compliance Committee will consider the facts and circumstances of the pending proxy vote and the potential or actual Conflict and make a determination as to how to vote the proxy — i.e., whether to permit or deny the recommendation of the portfolio manager, or whether to take other action, such as delegating the proxy vote to an independent third party or obtaining voting instructions from clients.

8.6 In considering the proxy vote and potential Conflict, the Compliance Committee may review the following factors, including but not limited to:

 

   

The percentage of outstanding securities of the issuer held on behalf of clients by the Firm.

 

   

The nature of the relationship of the issuer with the Firm, its affiliates or its executive officers.

 

   

Whether there has been any attempt to directly or indirectly influence the portfolio manager’s decision.

 

   

Whether the direction (for or against) of the proposed vote would appear to benefit the Firm or a related party.

 

   

Whether an objective decision to vote in a certain way will still create a strong appearance of a Conflict.

MacKay Shields may not abstain from voting any such proxy for the purpose of avoiding Conflict.

9. Securities Lending

MacKay Shields portfolio managers will monitor upcoming meetings and MacKay Shields will request that clients call back securities loans, if applicable, in anticipation of an important vote to be taken among holders of the securities or of the giving or withholding of their consent on a material matter affecting the investment. In determining whether to request that clients call back securities loans, the relevant portfolio manager(s) shall consider whether the benefit to the client in voting the matter outweighs the benefit to the client in keeping the security on loan.

 

B-23


Table of Contents

 

10. Reporting

Upon request, MacKay Shields shall report annually (or more frequently if specifically requested) to its clients on proxy votes cast on their behalf. MacKay Shields will provide any client who makes a written or verbal request with a copy of a report disclosing how MacKay Shields voted securities held in that client’s portfolio. The report will generally contain the following information:

 

   

The name of the issuer of the security;

 

   

The security’s exchange ticker symbol;

 

   

The security’s CUSIP number;

 

   

The shareholder meeting date;

 

   

A brief identification of the matter voted on;

 

   

Whether the matter was proposed by the issuer or by a security holder;

 

   

Whether MacKay Shields cast its vote on the matter;

 

   

How MacKay Shields voted; and

 

   

Whether MacKay Shields voted for or against management.

11. Record-Keeping

Either MacKay Shields or RM as indicated below will maintain the following records:

 

   

A copy of the Policy and MacKay’s Standard Guidelines;

 

   

A copy of each proxy statement received by MacKay Shields or forwarded to RM by the client’s custodian regarding client securities;

 

   

A record of each vote cast by MacKay Shields on behalf of a client;

 

   

A copy of all documents created by MacKay Shields that were material to making a decision on the proxy voting (or abstaining from voting) of client securities or that memorialize the basis for that decision including the resolution of any Conflict, a copy of all guideline override requests and all supporting documents; and

 

   

A copy of each written request by a client for information on how MacKay Shields voted proxies on behalf of the client, as well as a copy of any written response by MacKay Shields to any request by a client for information on how MacKay Shields voted proxies on behalf of the client; records of oral requests for information or oral responses will not be kept.

Such records must be maintained for at least eight years.

12. Review of Voting and Guidelines

As part of its periodic reviews, MacKay Shields’ Legal/Compliance Department will conduct an annual review of the prior year’s proxy voting as well as the guidelines established for proxy voting. Documentation shall be maintained of this review and a report setting forth the results of the review will be presented annually to the Compliance Committee.

 

B-24


Table of Contents

 

13. How to Request Information On How the Firm Voted Proxies

Clients may, at anytime, request and receive information from MacKay Shields as to how the Firm voted proxies for securities held in their account. Any such proxy information request should be in writing and mailed or faxed [(212)-754-9205] to MacKay Shields Client Services Department at:

MacKay Shields LLC

9 West 57th Street

New York, NY 10019

ATTN: Client Services

Attachments:

 

Exhibit A—

   Summary of Standard Guidelines for non-union clients

Exhibit B—

   Summary of Standard Guidelines for union clients (Taft-Hartley)

Schedule C—

   Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form

 

Effective February 12, 2010

 

B-25


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 

2010 U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines Summary

January 8, 2010

 

 

Copyright © 2009-2010 by RiskMetrics Group.

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.

Risk Management  |  RiskMetrics Labs  |  ISS Governance Services  |  Financial Research & Analysis

www.riskmetrics.com


Table of Contents

 

RiskMetrics Group

2010 U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines Summary

Effective for Meetings on or after Feb. 1, 2010

Published December 31, 2009

Updated Jan. 8, 2010

The following is a condensed version of the proxy voting recommendations contained in the RiskMetrics’ (RMG) U.S. Proxy Voting Manual.

 

Table of Contents

  

TABLE OF CONTENTS

     B-27   

1. ROUTINE/MISCELLANEOUS

     B-32   

Adjourn Meeting

     B-32   

Amend Quorum Requirements

     B-32   

Amend Minor Bylaws

     B-32   

Change Company Name

     B-32   

Change Date, Time, or Location of Annual Meeting

     B-32   

Other Business

     B-32   

Audit-Related

     B-32   

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

     B-32   

Auditor Ratification

     B-33   

Shareholder Proposals Limiting Non-Audit Services

     B-33   

Shareholder Proposals on Audit Firm Rotation

     B-33   

2. BOARD OF DIRECTORS:

     B-34   

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

     B-34   

Board Accountability

     B-34   

Problematic Takeover Defenses

     B-34   

Problematic Audit-Related Practices

     B-35   

Problematic Compensation Practices

     B-35   

Other Problematic Governance Practices

     B-36   

Board Responsiveness

     B-36   

Director Independence

     B-37   

Director Competence

     B-37   

2010 RMG Categorization of Directors

     B-37   

Board-Related Management Proposals

     B-40   

Age Limits

     B-40   

Board Size

     B-40   

Classification/Declassification of the Board

     B-40   

Cumulative Voting

     B-40   

Director and Officer Indemnification and Liability Protection

     B-40   

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

     B-41   

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

     B-41   

Majority Vote Threshold for Director Elections

     B-41   

Term Limits

     B-41   

Board-Related Shareholder Proposals/Initiatives

     B-41   

Age Limits

     B-41   

Annual Election (Declassification) of the Board

     B-41   

 

B-27


Table of Contents

Cumulative Voting

     B-42   

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

     B-42   

Establishment of Board Committees Shareholder Proposals

     B-42   

Establishment of Board Policy on Shareholder Engagement

     B-42   

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

     B-43   

Independent Chair (Separate Chair/CEO)

     B-43   

Majority of Independent Directors/Establishment of Independent Committees

     B-44   

Majority Vote Shareholder Proposals

     B-44   

Open Access (Proxy Access)

     B-44   

Proxy Contests- Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

     B-45   

Require More Nominees than Open Seats

     B-45   

Term Limits

     B-45   

Vote No Campaigns

     B-45   

3. SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS & DEFENSES

     B-45   

Advance Notice Requirements for Shareholder Proposals/Nominations

     B-45   

Amend Bylaws without Shareholder Consent

     B-46   

Confidential Voting

     B-46   

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

     B-46   

Control Share Cash-Out Provisions

     B-46   

Disgorgement Provisions

     B-47   

Fair Price Provisions

     B-47   

Freeze-Out Provisions

     B-47   

Greenmail

     B-47   

Net Operating Loss (NOL) Protective Amendments

     B-47   

Poison Pills- Shareholder Proposals to put Pill to a Vote and/or Adopt a Pill Policy

     B-48   

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to Ratify Poison Pill

     B-48   

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to ratify a Pill to preserve Net Operating Losses (NOLs)

     B-49   

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

     B-49   

Reincorporation Proposals

     B-49   

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

     B-50   

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

     B-50   

Stakeholder Provisions

     B-50   

State Antitakeover Statutes

     B-50   

Supermajority Vote Requirements

     B-51   

4. CAPITAL/RESTRUCTURING

     B-51   

Capital

     B-51   

Adjustments to Par Value of Common Stock

     B-51   

Common Stock Authorization

     B-51   

Issue Stock for Use with Rights Plan

     B-51   

Preemptive Rights

     B-52   

Preferred Stock

     B-52   

Recapitalization

     B-52   

Reverse Stock Splits

     B-52   

Share Repurchase Programs

     B-53   

Stock Distributions: Splits and Dividends

     B-53   

Tracking Stock

     B-53   

Restructuring

     B-53   

Appraisal Rights

     B-53   

Asset Purchases

     B-53   

Asset Sales

     B-54   

 

B-28


Table of Contents

Bundled Proposals

     B-54   

Conversion of Securities

     B-54   

Corporate Reorganization/Debt Restructuring/Prepackaged Bankruptcy Plans/Reverse Leveraged Buyouts/Wrap Plans

     B-54   

Formation of Holding Company

     B-55   

Going Private and Going Dark Transactions (LBOs and Minority Squeeze-outs)

     B-55   

Joint Ventures

     B-56   

Liquidations

     B-56   

Mergers and Acquisitions

     B-56   

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

     B-57   

Private Placements/Warrants/Convertible Debentures

     B-57   

Special Purpose Acquisition Corporations (SPACs)

     B-58   

Spinoffs

     B-59   

Value Maximization Shareholder Proposals

     B-59   

5. COMPENSATION

     B-60   

Executive Pay Evaluation

     B-60   

Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation- Management Proposals (Management Say-on-Pay)

     B-60   

Pay for Performance

     B-61   

Problematic Pay Practices

     B-62   

Non-Performance based Compensation Elements

     B-62   

Incentives that may Motivate Excessive Risk-Taking

     B-62   

Options Backdating

     B-63   

Board Communications and Responsiveness

     B-63   

Equity-Based and Other Incentive Plans

     B-64   

Cost of Equity Plans

     B-64   

Repricing Provisions

     B-64   

Three-Year Burn Rate/Burn Rate Commitment

     B-65   

Burn Rate Table for 2010

     B-65   

Pay-for-Performance- Impact on Equity Plans

     B-66   

Liberal Definition of Change-in-Control

     B-66   

Problematic Pay Practices

     B-66   

Specific Treatment of Certain Award Types in Equity Plan Evaluations:

     B-66   

Dividend Equivalent Rights

     B-66   

Liberal Share Recycling Provisions

     B-66   

Operating Partnership (OP) units in Equity Plan analysis of Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

     B-67   

Option Overhang Cost

     B-67   

Other Compensation Plans

     B-68   

401(k) Employee Benefit Plans

     B-68   

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

     B-68   

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Qualified Plans

     B-68   

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Non-Qualified Plans

     B-68   

Incentive Bonus Plans and Tax Deductibility Proposals (OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals)

     B-68   

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

     B-69   

Stock Plans in Lieu of Cash

     B-69   

Transfer Stock Option (TSO) Programs

     B-70   

Director Compensation

     B-70   

Equity Plans for Non-Employee Directors

     B-70   

Director Retirement Plans

     B-71   

 

B-29


Table of Contents

Shareholder Proposals on Compensation

     B-71   

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay)

     B-71   

Compensation Consultants- Disclosure of Board or Company’s Utilization

     B-71   

Disclosure/Setting Levels or Types of Compensation for Executives and Directors

     B-71   

Golden Coffins/Executive Death Benefits

     B-72   

Pay for Superior Performance

     B-72   

Performance-Based Awards

     B-73   

Pension Plan Income Accounting

     B-73   

Pre-Arranged Trading Plans (10b5-1 Plans)

     B-73   

Recoup Bonuses

     B-73   

Severance Agreements for Executives/Golden Parachutes

     B-74   

Share Buyback Holding Periods

     B-74   

Stock Ownership or Holding Period Guidelines

     B-74   

Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans (SERPs)

     B-75   

Termination of Employment Prior to Severance Payment and Eliminating Accelerated Vesting of Unvested Equity

     B-75   

Tax Gross-Up Proposals

     B-75   

6. SOCIAL/ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES

     B-76   

Overall Approach

     B-76   

Animal Welfare

     B-76   

Animal Testing

     B-76   

Animal Welfare Policies

     B-76   

Controlled Atmosphere Killing (CAK)

     B-77   

Consumer Issues

     B-77   

Genetically Modified Ingredients

     B-77   

Consumer Lending

     B-77   

Pharmaceutical Pricing, Access to Medicines, and Product Reimportation

     B-78   

Product Safety and Toxic/Hazardous Materials

     B-78   

Tobacco

     B-79   

Diversity

     B-79   

Board Diversity

     B-79   

Equality of Opportunity

     B-80   

Gender Identity, Sexual Orientation, and Domestic Partner Benefits

     B-80   

Climate Change and the Environment

     B-80   

Climate Change

     B-80   

Concentrated Animal Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

     B-80   

Energy Efficiency

     B-81   

Facility and Operational Safety/Security

     B-81   

Greenhouse Gas (GHG) Emissions

     B-81   

Operations in Protected Areas

     B-82   

Recycling

     B-82   

Renewable Energy

     B-82   

General Corporate Issues

     B-82   

Charitable Contributions

     B-82   

Environmental, Social, and Governance (ESG) Compensation-Related Proposals

     B-83   

Health Pandemics

     B-83   

Lobbying Expenditures/Initiatives

     B-83   

Political Contributions and Trade Associations Spending

     B-84   

 

B-30


Table of Contents

International Issues, Labor Issues, and Human Rights

     B-84   

Community Social and Environmental Impact Assessments

     B-84   

Foreign Military Sales/Offsets

     B-85   

Internet Privacy and Censorship

     B-85   

Labor and Human Rights Standards

     B-85   

MacBride Principles

     B-86   

Nuclear and Depleted Uranium Weapons

     B-86   

Operations in High Risk Markets

     B-86   

Outsourcing/Offshoring

     B-86   

Sustainability

     B-87   

Sustainability Reporting

     B-87   

7. MUTUAL FUND PROXIES

     B-87   

Election of Directors

     B-87   

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund

     B-87   

Proxy Contests

     B-87   

Investment Advisory Agreements

     B-88   

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares

     B-88   

Preferred Stock Proposals

     B-88   

1940 Act Policies

     B-88   

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Nonfundamental Restriction

     B-89   

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Nonfundamental

     B-89   

Name Change Proposals

     B-89   

Change in Fund’s Subclassification

     B-89   

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation

     B-89   

Changes to the Charter Document

     B-90   

Changing the Domicile of a Fund

     B-90   

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval

     B-90   

Distribution Agreements

     B-90   

Master-Feeder Structure

     B-91   

Mergers

     B-91   

Shareholder Proposals for Mutual Funds

     B-91   

Establish Director Ownership Requirement

     B-91   

Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred

     B-91   

Terminate the Investment Advisor

     B-91   

 

B-31


Table of Contents

 

1. Routine/Miscellaneous

Adjourn Meeting

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to provide management with the authority to adjourn an annual or special meeting absent compelling reasons to support the proposal.

Vote FOR proposals that relate specifically to soliciting votes for a merger or transaction if supporting that merger or transaction. Vote AGAINST proposals if the wording is too vague or if the proposal includes “other business.”

Amend Quorum Requirements

Vote AGAINST proposals to reduce quorum requirements for shareholder meetings below a majority of the shares outstanding unless there are compelling reasons to support the proposal.

Amend Minor Bylaws

Vote FOR bylaw or charter changes that are of a housekeeping nature (updates or corrections).

Change Company Name

Vote FOR proposals to change the corporate name.

Change Date, Time, or Location of Annual Meeting

Vote FOR management proposals to change the date, time, and/or location of the annual meeting unless the proposed change is unreasonable.

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to change the date, time, and/or location of the annual meeting unless the current scheduling or location is unreasonable.

Other Business

Vote AGAINST proposals to approve other business when it appears as voting item.

Audit-Related

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

Consider the issue of auditor indemnification and limitation of liability on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Factors to be assessed include, but are not limited to:

 

   

The terms of the auditor agreement- the degree to which these agreements impact shareholders’ rights;

 

B-32


Table of Contents
   

Motivation and rationale for establishing the agreements;

 

   

Quality of disclosure; and

 

   

Historical practices in the audit area.

WITHHOLD or vote AGAINST members of an audit committee in situations where there is persuasive evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.

Auditor Ratification

Vote FOR proposals to ratify auditors, unless any of the following apply:

 

   

An auditor has a financial interest in or association with the company, and is therefore not independent;

 

   

There is reason to believe that the independent auditor has rendered an opinion which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

 

   

Poor accounting practices are identified that rise to a serious level of concern, such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures; or

 

   

Fees for non-audit services (“Other” fees) are excessive.

Non-audit fees are excessive if:

 

   

Non-audit (“other”) fees > audit fees + audit related fees + tax compliance/preparation fees

Tax compliance and preparation include the preparation of original and amended tax returns, refund claims and tax payment planning. All other services in the tax category, such as tax advice, planning or consulting should be added “Other” fees. If the breakout of tax fees cannot be determined, add all tax fees to “Other “ fees.

In circumstances where “Other” fees include fees related to significant one-time capital structure events: initial public offerings, bankruptcy emergence, and spin-offs; and the company makes public disclosure of the amount and nature of those fees which are an exception to the standard “non-audit fee” category, then such fees may be excluded from the non-audit fees considered in determining the ratio of non-audit to audit/audit-related fees/tax compliance and preparation for purposes of determining whether non-audit fees are excessive.

Shareholder Proposals Limiting Non-Audit Services

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking companies to prohibit or limit their auditors from engaging in non-audit services.

Shareholder Proposals on Audit Firm Rotation

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking for audit firm rotation, taking into account:

 

   

The tenure of the audit firm;

 

   

The length of rotation specified in the proposal;

 

   

Any significant audit-related issues at the company;

 

   

The number of Audit Committee meetings held each year;

 

B-33


Table of Contents

 

   

The number of financial experts serving on the committee; and

 

   

Whether the company has a periodic renewal process where the auditor is evaluated for both audit quality and competitive price.

2. Board of Directors:

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

Votes on director nominees should be determined on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Four fundamental principles apply when determining votes on director nominees:

 

   

Board Accountability: Practices that promote accountability include: transparency into a company’s governance practices; annual board elections; and providing shareholders the ability to remove problematic directors and to vote on takeover defenses or other charter/bylaw amendments. These practices help reduce the opportunity for management entrenchment.

 

   

Board Responsiveness: Directors should be responsive to shareholders, particularly in regard to shareholder proposals that receive a majority vote and to tender offers where a majority of shares are tendered. Furthermore, shareholders should expect directors to devote sufficient time and resources to oversight of the company.

 

   

Director Independence: Without independence from management, the board may be unwilling or unable to effectively set company strategy and scrutinize performance or executive compensation.

 

   

Director Competence: Companies should seek directors who can add value to the board through specific skills or expertise and who can devote sufficient time and commitment to serve effectively. While directors should not be constrained by arbitrary limits such as age or term limits, directors who are unable to attend board and committee meetings and/or who are overextended (i.e. serving on too many boards) raise concern on the director’s ability to effectively serve in shareholders’ best interests.

Board Accountability

Problematic Takeover Defenses

VOTE WITHHOLD/AGAINST1 the entire board of directors (except new nominees2, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis), if:

 

   

The board is classified, and a continuing director responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote recommendation is not up for election — any or all appropriate nominees (except new) may be held accountable;

 

   

The company’s poison pill has a “dead-hand” or “modified dead-hand feature. Vote withhold/against every year until this feature is removed;

 

 

1

In general, companies with a plurality vote standard use “withhold” as the valid contrary vote option in director elections; companies with a majority vote standard use “Against”. However, it will vary by company and the proxy must be checked to determine the valid contrary vote option for the particular company.

2

A “new nominee” is any current nominee who has not already been elected by shareholders and who joined the board after the problematic action in question transpired. If RMG cannot determine whether the nominee joined the board before or after the problematic action transpired, the nominee will be considered a “new nominee” if he or she joined the board within the 12 months prior to the upcoming shareholder meeting.

 

B-34


Table of Contents

 

   

The board adopts a poison pill with -term aterm pill”), of existing pill, including any “short-term” pill (12 months or less), commitment or policy that puts a newly-adopted pill to a binding shareholder vote may potentially offset an adverse vote recommendation. Review such companies with classified boards every year, and such companies with annually-elected boards at least once every three years, and vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees if the company still maintains a non-shareholder-approved poison pill. This policy applies to all companies adopting or renewing pills after the announcement of this policy (Nov 19, 2009);

 

   

The board makes a material adverse change to an existing poison pill without shareholder approval.

Vote CASE-By-CASE on all nominees if the board adopts a poison pill with a term of 12 months or less (“short-term pill”) without shareholder approval, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

The date of the pill’s adoption relative to the date of the next meeting of shareholders- i.e. whether the company had time to put the pill on ballot for shareholder ratification given the circumstances;

 

   

The issuer’s rationale;

 

   

The issuer’s governance structure and practices; and

 

   

The issuer’s track record of accountability to shareholders.

Problematic Audit-Related Practices

Generally, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from the members of the Audit Committee if:

 

   

The non-audit fees paid to the auditor are excessive (see discussion under “Auditor Ratification”);

 

   

The company receives an adverse opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditor; or

 

   

There is persuasive evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.

Vote CASE-by-CASE on members of the Audit Committee and/or the full board if:

 

   

Poor accounting practices are identified that rise to a level of serious concern, such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures. Examine the severity, breadth, chronological sequence and duration, as the company’s efforts at remediation or corrective actions, in determining whether WITHHOLD/AGAINST votes are warranted.

Problematic Compensation Practices

VOTE WITHHOLD/AGAINST the members of the Compensation Committee and potentially the full board if:

 

   

There is a negative correlation between chief executive pay and company performance (see Pay for Performance Policy);

 

   

The company reprices underwater options for stock, cash, or other consideration without prior shareholder approval, even if allowed in the firm’s equity plan;

 

   

The company fails to submit one-time transfers of stock options to a shareholder vote;

 

   

The company fails to fulfill the terms of a burn rate commitment made to shareholders;

 

   

The company has problematic pay practices. Problematic pay practices may warrant withholding votes from the CEO and potentially the entire board as well.

 

B-35


Table of Contents

 

Other Problematic Governance Practices

VOTE WITHHOLD/AGAINST the entire board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis), if:

 

   

The company’s proxy indicates that not all directors attended 75 percent of the aggregate board and committee meetings, but fails to provide the required disclosure of the names of the director(s) involved. If this information cannot be obtained, withhold from all incumbent directors;

 

   

The board lacks accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers. Sustained poor performance is measured by one- and three-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). Take into consideration the company’s five-year total shareholder return and five-year operational metrics. Problematic provisions include but are not limited to:

 

  A classified board structure;

 

  A supermajority vote requirement;

 

  Majority vote standard for director elections with no carve out for contested elections;

 

  The inability for shareholders to call special meetings;

 

  The inability for shareholders to act by written consent;

 

  A dual-class structure; and/or

 

  A non-shareholder approved poison pill.

Under extraordinary circumstances, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from directors individually, committee members, or the entire board, due to:

 

   

Material failures of governance, stewardship, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company;

 

   

Failure to replace management as appropriate; or

 

   

Egregious actions related to the director(s) service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.

Board Responsiveness

Vote WITHHOLD/AGAINST the entire board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis), if:

 

   

The board failed to act on a shareholder proposal that received approval by a majority of the shares outstanding the previous year (a management proposal with other than a FOR recommendation by management will not be considered as sufficient action taken);

 

   

The board failed to act on a shareholder proposal that received approval of the majority of shares cast for the previous two consecutive years (a management proposal with other than a FOR recommendation by management will not be considered as sufficient action taken);

 

   

The board failed to act on takeover offers where the majority of the shareholders tendered their shares; or

 

   

At the previous board election, any director received more than 50 percent withhold/against votes of the shares cast and the company has failed to address the issue(s) that caused the high withhold/against vote.

 

B-36


Table of Contents

 

Director Independence

Vote WITHHOLD/AGAINST Inside Directors and Affiliated Outside Directors (per the Categorization of Directors) when:

 

   

The inside or affiliated outside director serves on any of the three key committees: audit, compensation, or nominating;

 

   

The company lacks an audit, compensation, or nominating committee so that the full board functions as that committee;

 

   

The company lacks a formal nominating committee, even if the board attests that the independent directors fulfill the functions of such a committee; or

 

   

The full board is less than majority independent.

Director Competence

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from individual directors who:

 

   

Attend less than 75 percent of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse, such as illness, service to the nation, work on behalf of the company, or funeral obligations. If the company provides meaningful public or private disclosure explaining the director’s absences, evaluate the information on a CASE-BY-CASE basis taking into account the following factors:

 

  Degree to which absences were due to an unavoidable conflict;

 

  Pattern of absenteeism; and

 

  Other extraordinary circumstances underlying the director’s absence;

 

   

Sit on more than six public company boards;

 

   

Are CEOs of public companies who sit on the boards of more than two public companies besides their own — withhold only at their outside boards.

2010 RMG Categorization of Directors

 

1. Inside Director (I)

 

  1.1.

Employee of the company or one of its affiliatesi.

 

  1.2. Among the five most highly paid individuals (excluding interim CEO).

 

  1.3.

Listed as an officer as defined under Section 16 of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 (“section 16 officer”)ii.

 

  1.4. Current interim CEO.

 

  1.5. Beneficial owner of more than 50 percent of the company’s voting power (this may be aggregated if voting power is distributed among more than one member of a defined group).

 

2. Affiliated Outside Director (AO)

Board Attestation

 

  2.1. Board attestation that an outside director is not independent.

Former CEO

 

  2.2.

Former CEO of the companyiii,iv.

 

  2.3.

Former CEO of an acquired company within the past five yearsiv.

 

B-37


Table of Contents

 

  2.4.

Former interim CEO if the service was longer than 18 months. If the service was between twelve and eighteen months an assessment of the interim CEO’s employment agreement will be madev.

Non-CEO Executives

 

  2.5.

Former Section 16 officerii of the company, an affiliatei or an acquired firm within the past five years.

 

  2.6.

Section 16 officerii of a former parent or predecessor firm at the time the company was sold or split off from the parent/predecessor within the past five years.

 

  2.7.

Section 16 officerii, former Section 16 officer, or general or limited partner of a joint venture or partnership with the company.

Family Members

 

  2.8.

Immediate family membervi of a current or former Section 16 officerii of the company or its affiliatesi within the last five years.

 

  2.9.

Immediate family membervi of a current employee of company or its affiliatesi where additional factors raise concern (which may include, but are not limited to, the following: a director related to numerous employees; the company or its affiliates employ relatives of numerous board members; or a non-Section 16 officer in a key strategic role).

Transactional, Professional, Financial, and Charitable Relationships

 

  2.10.

Currently provides (or an immediate family membervi provides) professional servicesvii to the company, to an affiliatei of the company or an individual officer of the company or one of its affiliates in excess of $10,000 per year.

 

  2.11.

Is (or an immediate family membervi is) a partner in, or a controlling shareholder or an employee of, an organization which provides professional servicesvii to the company, to an affiliatei of the company, or an individual officer of the company or one of its affiliates in excess of $10,000 per year.

 

  2.12.

Has (or an immediate family membervi has) any material transactional relationshipviii with the company or its affiliatesi (excluding investments in the company through a private placement).

 

  2.13.

Is (or an immediate family membervi is) a partner in, or a controlling shareholder or an executive officer of, an organization which has any material transactional relationshipviii with the company or its affiliatesi (excluding investments in the company through a private placement).

 

  2.14.

Is (or an immediate family membervi is) a trustee, director, or employee of a charitable or non-profit organization that receives material grants or endowmentsviii from the company or its affiliatesi.

Other Relationships

 

  2.15.

Party to a voting agreementix to vote in line with management on proposals being brought to shareholder vote.

 

  2.16.

Has (or an immediate family membervi has) an interlocking relationship as defined by the SEC involving members of the board of directors or its Compensation Committeex.

 

  2.17.

Founderxi of the company but not currently an employee.

 

  2.18.

Any materialxii relationship with the company.

 

3. Independent Outside Director (IO)

 

  3.1.

No materialxii connection to the company other than a board seat.

Footnotes:

i

“Affiliate” includes a subsidiary, sibling company, or the parent company. RMG uses 50 percent control ownership by the parent company as the standard for applying its affiliate designation.

 

B-38


Table of Contents
ii

“Section 16 officer” (officers subject to Section 16 of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934) includes the chief executive, operating, financial, legal, technology, and accounting officers of a company (including the president, treasurer, secretary, controller, or any vice president in charge of a principal business unit, division, or policy function). A non-employee director serving as an officer due to statutory requirements (e.g. corporate secretary) will be classified as an Affiliated Outsider. If the company provides explicit disclosure that the director is not receiving additional compensation in excess of $10,000 per year for serving in that capacity, then the director will be classified as an Independent Outsider.

iii

Includes any former CEO of the company prior to the company’s initial public offering (IPO).

iv

When there is a former CEO of a special purpose acquisition company (SPAC) serving on the board of an acquired company, RMG will generally classify such directors as independent unless determined otherwise taking into account the following factors: the applicable listing standards determination of such director’s independence; any operating ties to the firm; and the existence of any other conflicting relationships or related party transactions.

v

RMG will look at the terms of the interim CEO’s employment contract to determine if it contains serverance pay, long-term health and pension benefits, or other such standard provisions typically contained in contracts of permanent, non-temporary CEOs. RMG will also consider if a formal search process was underway for a full-time CEO at the time.

vi

“Immediate family member” follows the SEC’s definition of such and cover spouses, parents, children, step-parents, step-children, siblings, in-laws, and any person (other than a tenant or employee) sharing the household of any director, nominee for director, executive officer, or significant shareholder of the company.

vii

Professional services can be characterized as advisory in nature, generally involve access to sensitive company information or to strategic decision-making, and typically have a commission- or fee-based payment structure. Professional services generally include, but are not limited to the following: investment banking/financial advisory services; commercial banking (beyond deposit services); investment services; insurance services; accounting/audit services; consulting services; marketing services; legal services; property management services; realtor services; lobbying services; executive search services; and IT consulting services. The following would generally be considered transactional relationships and not professional services: deposit services; IT tech support services; educational services; and construction services. The case of participation in a banking syndicate by a non-lead bank should be considered a transactional (and hence subject to the associated materiality test) rather than a professional relationship. “Of Counsel” relationships are only considered immaterial if the individual does not receive any form of compensation (in excess of $10,000 per year) from, or is a retired partner of, the firm providing the professional service. The case of a company providing a professional service to one of its directors or to an entity with which one of its directors is affiliated, will be considered a transactional rather than a professional relationship. Insurance services and marketing services are assumed to be professional services unless the company explains why such services are not advisory.

viii

A material transactional relationship, including grants to non-profit organizations, exists if the company makes annual payments to, or receives annual payments from, another entity exceeding the greater of $200,000 or 5 percent of the recipient’s gross revenues, in the case of a company which follows NASDAQ listing standards; or the greater of $1,000,000 or 2 percent of the recipient’s gross revenues, in the case of a company which follows NYSE/Amex listing standards. In the case of a company which follows neither of the preceding standards, RMG will apply the NASDAQ-based materiality test. (The recipient is the party receiving the financial proceeds from the transaction).

ix

Dissident directors who are parties to a voting agreement pursuant to a settlement arrangement, will generally be classified as independent unless determined otherwise taking into account the following factors: the terms of the agreement; the duration of the standstill provision in the agreement; the limitations and requirements of actions that are agreed upon; if the dissident director nominee(s) is subject to the standstill; and if there any conflicting relationships or related party transactions.

x

Interlocks include: executive officers serving as directors on each other’s compensation or similar committees (or, in the absence of such a committee, on the board); or executive officers sitting on each other’s boards and at least one serves on the other’s compensation or similar committees (or in the absence of such a committee on the board).

 

B-39


Table of Contents
xi

The operating involvement of the founder with the company will be considered. Little to no operating involvement may cause RMG to deem the founder as an independent outsider.

xii

For purposes of RMG’s director independence classification, “material” will be defined as a standard of relationship (financial, personal or otherwise) that a reasonable person might conclude could potentially influence one’s objectivity in the boardroom in a manner that would have a meaningful impact on an individual’s ability to satisfy requisite fiduciary standards on behalf of shareholders.

Board-Related Management Proposals

Age Limits

Vote AGAINST management proposal to limit the tenure of outside directors through mandatory retirement ages.

Board Size

Vote FOR proposals seeking to fix the board size or designate a range for the board size.

Vote AGAINST proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board outside of a specified range without shareholder approval.

Classification/Declassification of the Board

Vote AGAINST proposals to classify (stagger) the board.

Vote FOR proposals to repeal classified boards and to elect all directors annually.

Cumulative Voting

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to eliminate cumulative voting.

Director and Officer Indemnification and Liability Protection

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals on director and officer indemnification and liability protection using Delaware law as the standard.

Vote AGAINST proposals to eliminate entirely directors’ and officers’ liability for monetary damages for violating the duty of care.

Vote AGAINST indemnification proposals that would expand coverage beyond just legal expenses to liability for acts, such as negligence, that are more serious violations of fiduciary obligation than mere carelessness.

Vote AGAINST proposals that would expand the scope of indemnification to provide for mandatory indemnification of company officials in connection with acts that previously the company was permitted to provide indemnification for at the discretion of the company’s board (i.e., “permissive indemnification”) but that previously the company was not required to indemnify.

 

B-40


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR only those proposals providing such expanded coverage in cases when a director’s or officer’s legal defense was unsuccessful if both of the following apply:

 

   

If the director was found to have acted in good faith and in a manner that he reasonably believed was in the best interests of the company; and

 

   

If only the director’s legal expenses would be covered.

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals that establish or amend director qualifications. Votes should be based on how reasonable the criteria are and to what degree they may preclude dissident nominees from joining the board.

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause.

Vote FOR proposals to restore shareholders’ ability to remove directors with or without cause.

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

Vote FOR proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

Majority Vote Threshold for Director Elections

Generally vote FOR management proposals to adopt a majority of votes cast standard for directors in uncontested elections. Vote AGAINST if no carve-out for plurality in contested elections is included.

Term Limits

Vote AGAINST management proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors through term limits. However, scrutinize boards where the average tenure of all directors exceeds 15 years for independence from management and for sufficient turnover to ensure that new perspectives are being added to the board.

Board-Related Shareholder Proposals/Initiatives

Age Limits

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors through mandatory retirement ages.

Annual Election (Declassification) of the Board

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to repeal classified (staggered) boards and to elect all directors annually.

 

B-41


Table of Contents

 

Cumulative Voting

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals to restore or provide for cumulative voting unless:

 

   

The company has proxy access or a similar structure3 to allow shareholders to nominate directors to the company’s ballot; and

 

   

The company has adopted a majority vote standard, with a carve-out for plurality voting in situations where there are more nominees than seats, and a director resignation policy to address failed elections.

Vote FOR proposals for cumulative voting at controlled companies (insider voting power > 50%).

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals that establish or amend director qualifications. Votes should be based on the reasonableness of the criteria and to what degree they may preclude dissident nominees from joining the board.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder resolutions seeking a director nominee candidate who possesses a particular subject matter expertise, considering:

 

   

The company’s board committee structure, existing subject matter expertise, and board nomination provisions relative to that of its peers;

 

   

The company’s existing board and management oversight mechanisms regarding the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

The company disclosure and performance relating to the issue for which board oversight is sought and any significant related controversies; and

 

   

The scope and structure of the proposal.

Establishment of Board Committees Shareholder Proposals

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to establish a new board committee, as such proposals seek a specific oversight mechanism/structure that potentially limits a company’s flexibility to determine an appropriate oversight mechanism for itself. However, the following factors will be considered:

 

   

Existing oversight mechanisms (including current committee structure) regarding the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

Level of disclosure regarding the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

Company performance related to the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

Board committee structure compared to that of other companies in its industry sector; and/or

 

   

The scope and structure of the proposal.

Establishment of Board Policy on Shareholder Engagement

Generally vote FOR shareholders proposals requesting that the board establish an internal mechanism/process, which may include a committee, in order to improve communications between directors and shareholders, unless the company has the following features, as appropriate:

 

   

Established a communication structure that goes beyond the exchange requirements to facilitate the exchange of information between shareholders and members of the board;

 

 

3

Similar structure” would be a structure that allows shareholders to nominate candidates who the company will include on the management ballot IN ADDITION TO management’s nominees, and their bios are included in management’s proxy.

 

B-42


Table of Contents
   

Effectively disclosed information with respect to this structure to its shareholders;

 

   

Company has not ignored majority-supported shareholder proposals or a majority withhold vote on a director nominee; and

 

   

The company has an independent chairman or a lead director, according to RMG’s definition. This individual must be made available for periodic consultation and direct communication with major shareholders.

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause.

Vote FOR proposals to restore shareholders’ ability to remove directors with or without cause.

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

Vote FOR proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

Independent Chair (Separate Chair/CEO)

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requiring that the chairman’s position be filled by an independent director, unless the company satisfies all of the following criteria:

The company maintains the following counterbalancing governance structure:

 

   

Designated lead director, elected by and from the independent board members with clearly delineated and comprehensive duties. (The role may alternatively reside with a presiding director, vice chairman, or rotating lead director; however the director must serve a minimum of one year in order to qualify as a lead director.) The duties should include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

  presides at all meetings of the board at which the chairman is not present, including executive sessions of the independent directors;

 

  serves as liaison between the chairman and the independent directors;

 

  approves information sent to the board;

 

  approves meeting agendas for the board;

 

  approves meeting schedules to assure that there is sufficient time for discussion of all agenda items;

 

  has the authority to call meetings of the independent directors;

 

  if requested by major shareholders, ensures that he is available for consultation and direct communication;

 

   

Two-thirds independent board;

 

   

All independent key committees;

 

   

Established governance guidelines;

 

   

A company in the Russell 3000 universe must not have exhibited sustained poor total shareholder return (TSR) performance, defined as one- and three-year TSR in the bottom half of the company’s

 

B-43


Table of Contents
 

four-digit GICS industry group (using Russell 3000 companies only), unless there has been a change in the Chairman/CEO position within that time. For companies not in the Russell 3000 universe, the company must not have underperformed both its peers and index on the basis of both one-year and three-year total shareholder returns, unless there has been a change in the Chairman/CEO position within that time;

 

   

The company does not have any problematic governance or management issues, examples of which include, but are not limited to:

 

  Egregious compensation practices;

 

  Multiple related-party transactions or other issues putting director independence at risk;

 

  Corporate and/or management scandals;

 

  Excessive problematic corporate governance provisions; or

 

  Flagrant actions by management or the board with potential or realized negative impacts on shareholders.

Majority of Independent Directors/Establishment of Independent Committees

Vote FOR shareholder proposals asking that a majority or more of directors be independent unless the board composition already meets the proposed threshold by RMG’s definition of independent outsider. (See Categorization of Directors.)

Vote FOR shareholder proposals asking that board audit, compensation, and/or nominating committees be composed exclusively of independent directors if they currently do not meet that standard.

Majority Vote Shareholder Proposals

Generally vote FOR precatory and binding resolutions requesting that the board change the company ‘s bylaws to stipulate that directors need to be elected with an affirmative majority of votes cast, provided it does not conflict with the state law where the company is incorporated. Binding resolutions need to allow for a carve-out for a plurality vote standard when there are more nominees than board seats.

Companies are strongly encouraged to also adopt a post-election policy (also know as a director resignation policy) that will provide guidelines so that the company will promptly address the situation of a holdover director.

Open Access (Proxy Access)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking for open or proxy access, taking into account:

 

   

The ownership threshold proposed in the resolution;

 

   

The proponent’s rationale for the proposal at the targeted company in terms of board and director conduct.

 

B-44


Table of Contents

Proxy Contests- Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the election of directors in contested elections, considering the following factors:

 

   

Long-term financial performance of the target company relative to its industry;

 

   

Management’s track record;

 

   

Background to the proxy contest;

 

   

Qualifications of director nominees (both slates);

 

   

Strategic plan of dissident slate and quality of critique against management;

 

   

Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates);

 

   

Stock ownership positions.

Require More Nominees than Open Seats

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that would require a company to nominate more candidates than the number of open board seats.

Term Limits

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors through term limits. However, scrutinize boards where the average tenure of all directors exceeds 15 years for independence from management and for sufficient turnover to ensure that new perspectives are being added to the board.

Vote No Campaigns

In cases where companies are targeted in connection with public “vote no” campaigns, evaluate director nominees under the existing governance policies for voting on director nominees in uncontested elections. Take into consideration the arguments submitted by shareholders and other publicly-available information.

3. Shareholder Rights  & Defenses

Advance Notice Requirements for Shareholder Proposals/Nominations

Vote CASE-BY-CASE basis on advance notice proposals, giving support to those proposals which allow shareholders to submit proposals/nominations as close to the meeting date as reasonably possible and within the broadest window possible, recognizing the need to allow sufficient notice for company, regulatory and shareholder review.

To be reasonable, the company’s deadline for shareholder notice of a proposal/nominations must not be more than 60 days prior to the meeting, with a submittal window of at least 30 days prior to the deadline. The submittal window is the period under which a shareholder must file his proposal/nominations prior to the deadline.

 

B-45


Table of Contents

 

In general, support additional efforts by companies to ensure full disclosure in regard to a proponent’s economic and voting position in the company so long as the informational requirements are reasonable and aimed at providing shareholders with the necessary information to review such proposals.

Amend Bylaws without Shareholder Consent

Vote AGAINST proposals giving the board exclusive authority to amend the bylaws.

Vote FOR proposals giving the board the ability to amend the bylaws in addition to shareholders.

Confidential Voting

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that corporations adopt confidential voting, use independent vote tabulators, and use independent inspectors of election, as long as the proposal includes a provision for proxy contests as follows: In the case of a contested election, management should be permitted to request that the dissident group honor its confidential voting policy. If the dissidents agree, the policy remains in place. If the dissidents will not agree, the confidential voting policy is waived.

Vote FOR management proposals to adopt confidential voting.

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

Control share acquisition statutes function by denying shares their voting rights when they contribute to ownership in excess of certain thresholds. Voting rights for those shares exceeding ownership limits may only be restored by approval of either a majority or supermajority of disinterested shares. Thus, control share acquisition statutes effectively require a hostile bidder to put its offer to a shareholder vote or risk voting disenfranchisement if the bidder continues buying up a large block of shares.

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share acquisition statutes unless doing so would enable the completion of a takeover that would be detrimental to shareholders.

Vote AGAINST proposals to amend the charter to include control share acquisition provisions.

Vote FOR proposals to restore voting rights to the control shares.

Control Share Cash-Out Provisions

Control share cash-out statutes give dissident shareholders the right to “cash-out” of their position in a company at the expense of the shareholder who has taken a control position. In other words, when an investor crosses a preset threshold level, remaining shareholders are given the right to sell their shares to the acquirer, who must buy them at the highest acquiring price.

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share cash-out statutes.

 

B-46


Table of Contents

 

Disgorgement Provisions

Disgorgement provisions require an acquirer or potential acquirer of more than a certain percentage of a company’s stock to disgorge, or pay back, to the company any profits realized from the sale of that company’s stock purchased 24 months before achieving control status. All sales of company stock by the acquirer occurring within a certain period of time (between 18 months and 24 months) prior to the investor’s gaining control status are subject to these recapture-of-profits provisions.

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of state disgorgement provisions.

Fair Price Provisions

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to adopt fair price provisions (provisions that stipulate that an acquirer must pay the same price to acquire all shares as it paid to acquire the control shares), evaluating factors such as the vote required to approve the proposed acquisition, the vote required to repeal the fair price provision, and the mechanism for determining the fair price.

Generally, vote AGAINST fair price provisions with shareholder vote requirements greater than a majority of disinterested shares.

Freeze-Out Provisions

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of state freeze-out provisions. Freeze-out provisions force an investor who surpasses a certain ownership threshold in a company to wait a specified period of time before gaining control of the company.

Greenmail

Greenmail payments are targeted share repurchases by management of company stock from individuals or groups seeking control of the company. Since only the hostile party receives payment, usually at a substantial premium over the market value of its shares, the practice discriminates against all other shareholders.

Vote FOR proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on anti-greenmail proposals when they are bundled with other charter or bylaw amendments.

Net Operating Loss (NOL) Protective Amendments

For management proposals to adopt a protective amendment for the stated purpose of protecting a company’s net operating losses (“NOLs”), the following factors should be considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

The ownership threshold (NOL protective amendments generally prohibit stock ownership transfers that would result in a new 5-percent holder or increase the stock ownership percentage of an existing five-percent holder);

 

   

The value of the NOLs;

 

B-47


Table of Contents

 

   

Shareholder protection mechanisms (sunset provision or commitment to cause expiration of the protective amendment upon exhaustion or expiration of the NOL);

 

   

The company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, track record of responsiveness to shareholders, and any other problematic governance concerns; and

 

   

Any other factors that may be applicable.

Poison Pills- Shareholder Proposals to put Pill to a Vote and/or Adopt a Pill Policy

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that the company submit its poison pill to a shareholder vote or redeem it UNLESS the company has: (1) A shareholder approved poison pill in place; or (2) The company has adopted a policy concerning the adoption of a pill in the future specifying that the board will only adopt a shareholder rights plan if either:

 

   

Shareholders have approved the adoption of the plan; or

 

   

The board, in its exercise of its fiduciary responsibilities, determines that it is in the best interest of shareholders under the circumstances to adopt a pill without the delay in adoption that would result from seeking stockholder approval (i.e., the “fiduciary out” provision). A poison pill adopted under this fiduciary out will be put to a shareholder ratification vote within 12 months of adoption or expire. If the pill is not approved by a majority of the votes cast on this issue, the plan will immediately terminate.

If the shareholder proposal calls for a time period of less than 12 months for shareholder ratification after adoption, vote FOR the proposal, but add the caveat that a vote within 12 months would be considered sufficient implementation.

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to Ratify Poison Pill

Vote CASE-by-CASE on management proposals on poison pill ratification, focusing on the features of the shareholder rights plan. Rights plans should contain the following attributes:

 

   

No lower than a 20% trigger, flip-in or flip-over;

 

   

A term of no more than three years;

 

   

No dead-hand, slow-hand, no-hand or similar feature that limits the ability of a future board to redeem the pill;

 

   

Shareholder redemption feature (qualifying offer clause); if the board refuses to redeem the pill 90 days after a qualifying offer is announced, 10 percent of the shares may call a special meeting or seek a written consent to vote on rescinding the pill.

In addition, the rationale for adopting the pill should be thoroughly explained by the company. In examining the request for the pill, take into consideration the company’s existing governance structure, including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, and any problematic governance concerns.

 

B-48


Table of Contents

 

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to ratify a Pill to preserve Net Operating Losses (NOLs)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on management proposals for poison pill ratification. For management proposals to adopt a poison pill for the stated purpose of preserving a company’s net operating losses (“NOLs”), the following factors are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

The ownership threshold to transfer (NOL pills generally have a trigger slightly below 5%);

 

   

The value of the NOLs;

 

   

The term;

 

   

Shareholder protection mechanisms (sunset provision, or commitment to cause expiration of the pill upon exhaustion or expiration of NOLs);

 

   

The company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, track record of responsiveness to shareholders, and any other problematic governance concerns; and

 

   

Any other factors that may be applicable.

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses. When voting in conjunction with support of a dissident slate, vote FOR the reimbursement of all appropriate proxy solicitation expenses associated with the election.

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for the reimbursement of reasonable costs incurred in connection with nominating one or more candidates in a contested election where the following apply:

 

   

The election of fewer than 50% of the directors to be elected is contested in the election;

 

   

One or more of the dissident’s candidates is elected;

 

   

Shareholders are not permitted to cumulate their votes for directors; and

 

   

The election occurred, and the expenses were incurred, after the adoption of this bylaw.

Reincorporation Proposals

Management or shareholder proposals to change a company’s state of incorporation should be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, giving consideration to both financial and corporate governance concerns including the following:

 

   

Reasons for reincorporation;

 

   

Comparison of company’s governance practices and provisions prior to and following the reincorporation; and

 

   

Comparison of corporation laws of original state and destination state

Vote FOR reincorporation when the economic factors outweigh any neutral or negative governance changes.

 

B-49


Table of Contents

 

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

Vote AGAINST management and shareholder proposals to restrict of prohibit shareholders’ to act by written consent.

Generally vote FOR management and shareholder proposals that provide shareholders with the ability to act by written consent taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Shareholders’ current right to act by written consent;

 

   

Consent threshold;

 

   

The inclusion of exclusionary or prohibitive language;

 

   

Investor ownership structure; and

 

   

Shareholder support of and management’s response to previous shareholder proposals.

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

Vote AGAINST management or shareholder proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholders’ ability to call special meetings.

Generally vote FOR management or shareholder proposals that provide shareholders with the ability to call special meetings taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Shareholders’ current right to call special meetings;

 

   

Minimum ownership threshold necessary to call special meetings (10% preferred);

 

   

The inclusion of exclusionary or prohibitive language;

 

   

Investor ownership structure; and

 

   

Shareholder support of and management’s response to previous shareholder proposals.

Stakeholder Provisions

Vote AGAINST proposals that ask the board to consider non-shareholder constituencies or other non-financial effects when evaluating a merger or business combination.

State Antitakeover Statutes

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to opt in or out of state takeover statutes (including control share acquisition statutes, control share cash-out statutes, freeze-out provisions, fair price provisions, stakeholder laws, poison pill endorsements, severance pay and labor contract provisions, anti-greenmail provisions, and disgorgement provisions).

 

B-50


Table of Contents

 

Supermajority Vote Requirements

Vote AGAINST proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote.

Vote FOR management or shareholder proposals to reduce supermajority vote requirements. However, for companies with shareholder(s) who have significant ownership levels, vote CASE-BY-CASE, taking into account:

 

   

Ownership structure;

 

   

Quorum requirements; and

 

   

Supermajority vote requirements.

4. CAPITAL/RESTRUCTURING

Capital

Adjustments to Par Value of Common Stock

Vote FOR management proposals to reduce the par value of common stock.

Common Stock Authorization

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to increase the number of shares of common stock authorized for issuance. Take into account company-specific factors which include, at a minimum, the following:

 

   

Past Board Performance:

 

   

The company’s use of authorized shares during the last three years;

 

   

One- and three-year total shareholder return; and

 

   

The board’s governance structure and practices;

 

   

The Current Request:

 

   

Disclosure in the proxy statement of the specific reasons for the proposed increase;

 

   

The dilutive impact of the request as determined through an allowable cap generated by

 

   

RiskMetrics’ quantitative model, which examines the company’s need for shares and its three-year total shareholder return; and

 

   

Risks to shareholders of not approving the request.

Vote AGAINST proposals at companies with more than one class of common stock to increase the number of authorized shares of the class that has superior voting rights.

Issue Stock for Use with Rights Plan

Vote AGAINST proposals that increase authorized common stock for the explicit purpose of implementing a non-shareholder approved shareholder rights plan (poison pill).

 

B-51


Table of Contents

 

Preemptive Rights

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals that seek preemptive rights, taking into consideration: the size of a company, the characteristics of its shareholder base, and the liquidity of the stock.

Preferred Stock

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to increase the number of shares of preferred stock authorized for issuance. Take into account company-specific factors that include, at a minimum, the following:

 

   

Past Board Performance:

 

   

The company’s use of authorized preferred shares during the last three years;

 

   

One- and three-year total shareholder return; and

 

   

The board’s governance structure and practices;

 

   

The Current Request:

 

   

Disclosure in the proxy statement of specific reasons for the proposed increase;

 

   

In cases where the company has existing authorized preferred stock, the dilutive impact of the request as determined through an allowable cap generated by RiskMetrics’ quantitative model, which examines the company’s need for shares and three-year total shareholder return;

 

   

Whether the shares requested are blank check preferred shares, and whether they are declawed.

Vote AGAINST proposals at companies with more than one class or series of preferred stock to increase the number of authorized shares of the class or series that has superior voting rights.

Recapitalization

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on recapitalizations (reclassifications of securities), taking into account the following:

 

   

More simplified capital structure;

 

   

Enhanced liquidity;

 

   

Fairness of conversion terms;

 

   

Impact on voting power and dividends;

 

   

Reasons for the reclassification;

 

   

Conflicts of interest; and

 

   

Other alternatives considered.

Reverse Stock Splits

Vote FOR management proposals to implement a reverse stock split when the number of authorized shares will be proportionately reduced.

Vote FOR management proposals to implement a reverse stock split to avoid delisting.

 

B-52


Table of Contents

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to implement a reverse stock split that do not proportionately reduce the number of shares authorized for issue based on the allowable increased calculated using the Capital Structure model.

Share Repurchase Programs

Vote FOR management proposals to institute open-market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

Stock Distributions: Splits and Dividends

Vote FOR management proposals to increase the common share authorization for a stock split or share dividend, provided that the increase in authorized shares would not result in an excessive number of shares available for issuance as determined using a model developed by RMG.

Tracking Stock

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the creation of tracking stock, weighing the strategic value of the transaction against such factors as:

 

   

Adverse governance changes;

 

   

Excessive increases in authorized capital stock;

 

   

Unfair method of distribution;

 

   

Diminution of voting rights;

 

   

Adverse conversion features;

 

   

Negative impact on stock option plans; and

 

   

Alternatives such as spin-off.

Restructuring

Appraisal Rights

Vote FOR proposals to restore, or provide shareholders with rights of appraisal.

Asset Purchases

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on asset purchase proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Purchase price;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

Financial and strategic benefits;

 

B-53


Table of Contents

 

   

How the deal was negotiated;

 

   

Conflicts of interest; Other alternatives for the business;

 

   

Non-completion risk.

Asset Sales

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on asset sales, considering the following factors:

 

   

Impact on the balance sheet/working capital;

 

   

Potential elimination of diseconomies;

 

   

Anticipated financial and operating benefits;

 

   

Anticipated use of funds;

 

   

Value received for the asset;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

How the deal was negotiated;

 

   

Conflicts of interest.

Bundled Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on bundled or “conditional” proxy proposals. In the case of items that are conditioned upon each other, examine the benefits and costs of the packaged items. In instances when the joint effect of the conditioned items is not in shareholders’ best interests, vote AGAINST the proposals. In the combined effect is positive, support such proposals.

Conversion of Securities

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding conversion of securities. When evaluating these proposals the investor should review the dilution to existing shareholders, the conversion price relative to market value, financial issues, control issues, termination penalties, and conflicts of interest.

Vote FOR the conversion if it is expected that the company will be subject to onerous penalties or will be forced to file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

Corporate Reorganization/Debt Restructuring/Prepackaged Bankruptcy Plans/Reverse Leveraged Buyouts/Wrap Plans

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to increase common and/or preferred shares and to issue shares as part of a debt restructuring plan, taking into consideration the following:

 

   

Dilution to existing shareholders’ position;

 

   

Terms of the offer;

 

   

Financial issues;

 

B-54


Table of Contents

 

   

Management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives;

 

   

Control issues;

 

   

Conflicts of interest.

Vote FOR the debt restructuring if it is expected that the company will file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

Formation of Holding Company

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding the formation of a holding company, taking into consideration the following:

 

   

The reasons for the change;

 

   

Any financial or tax benefits;

 

   

Regulatory benefits;

 

   

Increases in capital structure;

 

   

Changes to the articles of incorporation or bylaws of the company.

Absent compelling financial reasons to recommend the transaction, vote AGAINST the formation of a holding company if the transaction would include either of the following:

 

   

Increases in common or preferred stock in excess of the allowable maximum (see discussion under “Capital Structure”);

 

   

Adverse changes in shareholder rights.

Going Private and Going Dark Transactions (LBOs and Minority Squeeze-outs)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on going private transactions, taking into account the following:

 

   

Offer price/premium;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

How the deal was negotiated;

 

   

Conflicts of interest;

 

   

Other alternatives/offers considered; and

 

   

Non-completion risk.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on “going dark” transactions, determining whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by taking into consideration:

 

   

Whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly-traded (examination of trading volume, liquidity, and market research of the stock);

 

   

Balanced interests of continuing vs. cashed-out shareholders, taking into account the following:

 

  Are all shareholders able to participate in the transaction?

 

  Will there be a liquid market for remaining shareholders following the transaction?

 

B-55


Table of Contents

 

  Does the company have strong corporate governance?

 

  Will insiders reap the gains of control following the proposed transaction?

 

  Does the state of incorporation have laws requiring continued reporting that may benefit shareholders?

Joint Ventures

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to form joint ventures, taking into account the following:

 

   

Percentage of assets/business contributed;

 

   

Percentage ownership;

 

   

Financial and strategic benefits;

 

   

Governance structure;

 

   

Conflicts of interest;

 

   

Other alternatives;

 

   

Noncompletion risk.

Liquidations

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on liquidations, taking into account the following:

 

   

Management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives;

 

   

Appraisal value of assets; and

 

   

The compensation plan for executives managing the liquidation.

Vote FOR the liquidation if the company will file for bankruptcy if the proposal is not approved.

Mergers and Acquisitions

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on mergers and acquisitions. Review and evaluate the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors including:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, emphasis is placed on the offer premium, market reaction and strategic rationale.

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction should cause closer scrutiny of a deal.

 

   

Strategic rationale — Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions.

 

   

Negotiations and process — Were the terms of the transaction negotiated at arm’s-length? Was the process fair and equitable? A fair process helps to ensure the best price for shareholders. Significant

 

B-56


Table of Contents
 

negotiation “wins” can also signify the deal makers’ competency. The comprehensiveness of the sales process (e.g., full auction, partial auction, no auction) can also affect shareholder value.

 

   

Conflicts of interest — Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? As the result of potential conflicts, the directors and officers of the company may be more likely to vote to approve a merger than if they did not hold these interests. Consider whether these interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger. The CIC figure presented in the “RMG Transaction Summary” section of this report is an aggregate figure that can in certain cases be a misleading indicator of the true value transfer from shareholders to insiders. Where such figure appears to be excessive, analyze the underlying assumptions to determine whether a potential conflict exists.

 

   

Governance — Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance.

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE basis on proposals to common shareholders on bankruptcy plans of reorganization, considering the following factors including, but not limited to:

 

   

Estimated value and financial prospects of the reorganized company;

 

   

Percentage ownership of current shareholders in the reorganized company;

 

   

Whether shareholders are adequately represented in the reorganization process (particularly through the existence of an Official Equity Committee);

 

   

The cause(s) of the bankruptcy filing, and the extent to which the plan of reorganization addresses the cause(s);

 

   

Existence of a superior alternative to the plan of reorganization; and

 

   

Governance of the reorganized company.

Private Placements/Warrants/Convertible Debentures

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding private placements taking into consideration:

 

  1. Dilution to existing shareholders’ position.

 

  The amount and timing of shareholder ownership dilution should be weighed against the needs and proposed shareholder benefits of the capital infusion.

 

  2. Terms of the offer — discount/premium in purchase price to investor, including any fairness opinion; conversion features; termination penalties; exit strategy.

 

  The terms of the offer should be weighed against the alternatives of the company and in light of company’s financial issues.

 

  When evaluating the magnitude of a private placement discount or premium, RiskMetrics will consider whether it is affected by liquidity, due diligence, control and monitoring issues, capital scarcity, information asymmetry and anticipation of future performance.

 

B-57


Table of Contents

 

  3. Financial issues include but are not limited to examining the following:

 

  Company’s financial situation;

 

  Degree of need for capital;

 

  Use of proceeds;

 

  Effect of the financing on the company’s cost of capital;

 

  Current and proposed cash burn rate; and

 

  Going concern viability and the state of the capital and credit markets.

 

  4. Management’s efforts to pursue alternatives and whether the company engaged in a process to evaluate alternatives. A fair, unconstrained process helps to ensure the best price for shareholders. Financing alternatives can include joint ventures, partnership, merger or sale of part or all of the company.

 

  5. Control issues:

 

  Change in management;

 

  Change in control,

 

  Guaranteed board and committee seats;

 

  Standstill provisions;

 

  Voting agreements;

 

  Veto power over certain corporate actions.

Minority versus majority ownership and corresponding minority discount or majority control premium

 

  6. Conflicts of interest

 

  Conflicts of interest should be viewed from the perspective of the company and the investor.

 

  Were the terms of the transaction negotiated at arm’s-length? Are managerial incentives aligned with shareholder interests?

 

  7. Market reaction

 

  The market’s response to the proposed deal. A negative market reaction is a cause for concern. Market reaction may be addressed by analyzing the one day impact on the unaffected stock price.

Vote FOR the private placement if it is expected that the company will file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

Special Purpose Acquisition Corporations (SPACs)

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on SPAC mergers and acquisitions taking into account the following:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value being paid by the SPAC reasonable? SPACs generally lack an independent fairness opinion and the financials on the target may be limited. Compare the conversion price with the intrinsic value of the target company provided in the fairness opinion. Also, evaluate the proportionate value of the combined entity attributable to the SPAC IPO shareholders versus the pre-merger value of SPAC. Additionally, a private company discount may be applied to the target, if it is a private entity.

 

B-58


Table of Contents

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction may be a cause for concern. Market reaction may be addressed by analyzing the one-day impact on the unaffected stock price.

 

   

Deal timing — A main driver for most transactions is that the SPAC charter typically requires the deal to be complete within 18 to 24 months, or the SPAC is to be liquidated. Evaluate the valuation, market reaction, and potential conflicts of interest for deals that are announced close to the liquidation date.

 

   

Negotiations and process — What was the process undertaken to identify potential target companies within specified industry or location specified in charter? Consider the background of the sponsors.

 

   

Conflicts of interest — How are sponsors benefiting from the transaction compared to IPO shareholders? Potential conflicts could arise if a fairness opinion is issued by the insiders to qualify the deal rather than a third party or if management is encouraged to pay a higher price for the target because of an 80% rule (the charter requires that the fair market value of the target is at least equal to 80% of net assets of the SPAC). Also, there may be sense of urgency by the management team of the SPAC to close the deal since its charter typically requires a transaction to be completed within the 18-24 month timeframe.

 

   

Voting agreements — Are the sponsors entering into enter into any voting agreements/ tender offers with shareholders who are likely to vote AGAINST the proposed merger or exercise conversion rights?

 

   

Governance — What is the impact of having the SPAC CEO or founder on key committees following the proposed merger?

Spinoffs

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on spin-offs, considering:

 

   

Tax and regulatory advantages;

 

   

Planned use of the sale proceeds;

 

   

Valuation of spinoff;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

Benefits to the parent company;

 

   

Conflicts of interest;

 

   

Managerial incentives;

 

   

Corporate governance changes;

 

   

Changes in the capital structure.

Value Maximization Shareholder Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals seeking to maximize shareholder value by hiring a financial advisor to explore strategic alternatives, selling the company or liquidating the company and distributing the proceeds to shareholders. These proposals should be evaluated based on the following factors:

 

   

Prolonged poor performance with no turnaround in sight;

 

   

Signs of entrenched board and management;

 

   

Strategic plan in place for improving value;

 

B-59


Table of Contents

 

   

Likelihood of receiving reasonable value in a sale or dissolution; and

 

   

Whether company is actively exploring its strategic options, including retaining a financial advisor.

5. COMPENSATION

Executive Pay Evaluation

Underlying all evaluations are five global principles that most investors expect corporations to adhere to in designing and administering executive and director compensation programs:

 

  1. Maintain appropriate pay-for-performance alignment, with emphasis on long-term shareholder value: This principle encompasses overall executive pay practices, which must be designed to attract, retain, and appropriately motivate the key employees who drive shareholder value creation over the long term. It will take into consideration, among other factors, the link between pay and performance; the mix between fixed and variable pay; performance goals; and equity-based plan costs;

 

  2. Avoid arrangements that risk “pay for failure”: This principle addresses the appropriateness of long or indefinite contracts, excessive severance packages, and guaranteed compensation;

 

  3. Maintain an independent and effective compensation committee: This principle promotes oversight of executive pay programs by directors with appropriate skills, knowledge, experience, and a sound process for compensation decision-making (e.g., including access to independent expertise and advice when needed);

 

  4. Provide shareholders with clear, comprehensive compensation disclosures: This principle underscores the importance of informative and timely disclosures that enable shareholders to evaluate executive pay practices fully and fairly;

 

  5. Avoid inappropriate pay to non-executive directors: This principle recognizes the interests of shareholders in ensuring that compensation to outside directors does not compromise their independence and ability to make appropriate judgments in overseeing managers’ pay and performance. At the market level, it may incorporate a variety of generally accepted best practices.

Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation- Management Proposals (Management Say-on-Pay)

Evaluate executive pay and practices, as well as certain aspects of outside director compensation, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST management say on pay (MSOP) proposals, AGAINST/WITHHOLD on compensation committee members (or, in rare cases where the full board is deemed responsible, all directors including the CEO), and/or AGAINST an equity-based incentive plan proposal if:

 

   

There is a misalignment between CEO pay and company performance (pay for performance);

 

   

The company maintains problematic pay practices;

 

   

The board exhibits poor communication and responsiveness to shareholders.

Voting Alternatives

In general, the management say on pay (MSOP) ballot item is the primary focus of voting on executive pay practices — dissatisfaction with compensation practices can be expressed by voting against MSOP rather than

 

B-60


Table of Contents

withholding or voting against the compensation committee. However, if there is no MSOP on the ballot, then the negative vote will apply to members of the compensation committee. In addition, in egregious cases, or if the board fails to respond to concerns raised by a prior MSOP proposal, then vote withhold or against compensation committee members (or, if the full board is deemed accountable, all directors). If the negative factors involve equity-based compensation, then vote AGAINST an equity-based plan proposal presented for shareholder approval.

Additional CASE-BY-CASE considerations for the management say on pay (MSOP) proposals:

 

   

Evaluation of performance metrics in short-term and long-term plans, as discussed and explained in the Compensation Discussion & Analysis (CD&A). Consider the measures, goals, and target awards reported by the company for executives’ short- and long-term incentive awards: disclosure, explanation of their alignment with the company’s business strategy, and whether goals appear to be sufficiently challenging in relation to resulting payouts;

 

   

Evaluation of peer group benchmarking used to set target pay or award opportunities. Consider the rationale stated by the company for constituents in its pay benchmarking peer group, as well as the benchmark targets it uses to set or validate executives’ pay ( e.g., median, 75th percentile, etc.,) to ascertain whether the benchmarking process is sound or may result in pay “ratcheting” due to inappropriate peer group constituents (e.g., much larger companies) or targeting (e.g., above median); and

 

   

Balance of performance-based versus non-performance-based pay. Consider the ratio of performance-based (not including plain vanilla stock options) vs. non-performance-based pay elements reported for the CEO’s latest reported fiscal year compensation, especially in conjuction with concerns about other factors such as performance metrics/goals, benchmarking practices, and pay-for-performance disconnects.

Primary Evaluation Factors for Executive Pay

Pay for Performance

Evaluate the alignment of the CEO’s pay with performance over time, focusing particularly on companies that have underperformed their peers over a sustained period. From a shareholders’ perspective, performance is predominantly gauged by the company’s stock performance over time. Even when financial or operational measures are utilized in incentive awards, the achievement related to these measures should ultimately translate into superior shareholder returns in the long-term.

Focus on companies with sustained underperformance relative to peers, considering the following key factors:

 

   

Whether a company’s one-year and three-year total shareholder returns (“TSR”) are in the bottom half of its industry group (i.e., four-digit GICS – Global Industry Classification Group); and

 

   

Whether the total compensation of a CEO who has served at least two consecutive fiscal years is aligned with the company’s total shareholder return over time, including both recent and long-term periods.

If a company falls in the bottom half of its four-digit GICS, further analysis of the CD&A is required to better understand the various pay elements and whether they create or reinforce shareholder alignment. Also assess the CEO’s pay relative to the company’s TSR over a time horizon of at least five years. The most recent year-over-year increase or decrease in pay remains a key consideration, but there will be additional emphasis on the long term trend of CEO total compensation relative to shareholder return. Also consider the mix of performance-based compensation relative to total compensation. In general, standard stock options or time-vested restricted stock are not considered to be performance-based. If a company provides performance-based

 

B-61


Table of Contents

incentives to its executives, the company is highly encouraged to provide the complete disclosure of the performance measure and goals (hurdle rate) so that shareholders can assess the rigor of the performance program. The use of non-GAAP financial metrics also makes it very challenging for shareholders to ascertain the rigor of the program as shareholders often cannot tell the type of adjustments being made and if the adjustments were made consistently. Complete and transparent disclosure helps shareholders to better understand the company’s pay for performance linkage.

Problematic Pay Practices

The focus is on executive compensation practices that contravene the global pay principles, including:

 

   

Problematic practices related to non-performance-based compensation elements;

 

   

Incentives that may motivate excessive risk-taking; and

 

   

Options Backdating.

Non-Performance based Compensation Elements

Companies adopt a variety of pay arrangements that may be acceptable in their particular industries, or unique for a particular situation, and all companies are reviewed on a case-by-case basis. However, there are certain adverse practices that are particularly contrary to a performance-based pay philosophy, including guaranteed pay and excessive or inappropriate non-performance-based pay elements.

While not exhaustive, this is the list of practices that carry greatest weight in this consideration and may result in negative vote recommendations on a stand-alone basis. For more details, please refer to RMG’s Compensation FAQ document: http://www.riskmetrics.com/policy/2010_compensation_FAQ:

 

   

Multi-year guarantees for salary increases, non-performance based bonuses, and equity compensation;

 

   

Including additional years of unworked service that result in significant additional benefits, without sufficient justification, or including long-term equity awards in the pension calculation;

 

   

Perquisites for former and/or retired executives, and extraordinary relocation benefits (including home buyouts) for current executives;

 

   

Change-in-control payments exceeding 3 times base salary and target bonus; change-in-control payments without job loss or substantial diminution of duties (“Single Triggers”); new or materially amended agreements that provide for “modified single triggers” (under which an executive may voluntarily leave for any reason and still receive the change-in-control severance package); new or materially amended agreements that provide for an excise tax gross-up (including “modified gross-ups”) ;

 

   

Tax Reimbursements related to executive perquisites or other payments such as personal use of corporate aircraft, executive life insurance, bonus, etc; (see also excise tax gross-ups above)

 

   

Dividends or dividend equivalents paid on unvested performance shares or units;

 

   

Executives using company stock in hedging activities, such as “cashless” collars, forward sales, equity swaps or other similar arrangements; or

 

   

Repricing or replacing of underwater stock options/stock appreciation rights without prior shareholder approval (including cash buyouts and voluntary surrender/subsequent regrant of underwater options).

Incentives that may Motivate Excessive Risk-Taking

Assess company policies and disclosure related to compensation that could incentivize excessive risk-taking, for example:

 

   

Guaranteed bonuses;

 

B-62


Table of Contents

 

   

A single performance metric used for short- and long-term plans;

 

   

Lucrative severance packages;

 

   

High pay opportunities relative to industry peers;

 

   

Disproportionate supplemental pensions; or

 

   

Mega annual equity grants that provide unlimited upside with no downside risk.

Factors that potentially mitigate the impact of risky incentives include rigorous claw-back provisions and robust stock ownership/holding guidelines.

Options Backdating

Vote CASE-by-CASE on options backdating issues. Generally, when a company has recently practiced options backdating, WITHHOLD from or vote AGAINST the compensation committee, depending on the severity of the practices and the subsequent corrective actions on the part of the board. When deciding on votes on compensation committee members who oversaw questionable options grant practices or current compensation committee members who fail to respond to the issue proactively, consider several factors, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Reason and motive for the options backdating issue, such as inadvertent vs. deliberate grant date changes;

 

   

Duration of options backdating;

 

   

Size of restatement due to options backdating;

 

   

Corrective actions taken by the board or compensation committee, such as canceling or re-pricing backdated options, the recouping of option gains on backdated grants; and

 

   

Adoption of a grant policy that prohibits backdating, and creates a fixed grant schedule or window period for equity grants in the future.

A CASE-by-CASE analysis approach allows distinctions to be made between companies that had “sloppy” plan administration versus those that acted deliberately and/or committed fraud, as well as those companies that subsequently took corrective action. Cases where companies have committed fraud are considered most egregious.

Board Communications and Responsiveness

Consider the following factors on a CASE-BY-CASE basis when evaluating ballot items related to executive pay:

 

   

Poor disclosure practices, including:

 

  Unclear explanation of how the CEO is involved in the pay setting process;

 

  Retrospective performance targets and methodology not discussed;

 

  Methodology for benchmarking practices and/or peer group not disclosed and explained.

 

   

Board’s responsiveness to investor input and engagement on compensation issues, for example:

 

  Failure to respond to majority-supported shareholder proposals on executive pay topics; or

 

  Failure to respond to concerns raised in connection with significant opposition to MSOP proposals.

 

B-63


Table of Contents

 

Equity-Based and Other Incentive Plans

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on equity-based compensation plans. Vote AGAINST the equity plan if any of the following factors apply:

 

   

The total cost of the company’s equity plans is unreasonable;

 

   

The plan expressly permits the repricing of stock options/stock appreciate rights (SARs) without prior shareholder approval;

 

   

The CEO is a participant in the proposed equity-based compensation plan and there is a disconnect between CEO pay and the company’s performance where over 50 percent of the year-over-year increase is attributed to equity awards (see Pay-for-Performance);

 

   

The company’s three year burn rate exceeds the greater of 2% or the mean plus one standard deviation of its industry group;

 

   

Liberal Change of Control Definition: The plan provides for the acceleration of vesting of equity awards even though an actual change in control may not occur (e.g., upon shareholder approval of a transaction or the announcement of a tender offer); or

 

   

The plan is a vehicle for problematic pay practices.

Each of these factors is described below:

Cost of Equity Plans

Generally, vote AGAINST equity plans if the cost is unreasonable. For non-employee director plans, vote FOR the plan if certain factors are met (see Director Compensation section).

The cost of the equity plans is expressed as Shareholder Value Transfer (SVT), which is measured using a binomial option pricing model that assesses the amount of shareholders’ equity flowing out of the company to employees and directors. SVT is expressed as both a dollar amount and as a percentage of market value, and includes the new shares proposed, shares available under existing plans, and shares granted but unexercised. All award types are valued. For omnibus plans, unless limitations are placed on the most expensive types of awards (for example, full value awards), the assumption is made that all awards to be granted will be the most expensive types. See discussion of specific types of awards.

The Shareholder Value Transfer is reasonable if it falls below the company-specific allowable cap. The allowable cap is determined as follows: The top quartile performers in each industry group (using the Global Industry Classification Standard: GICS) are identified. Benchmark SVT levels for each industry are established based on these top performers’ historic SVT. Regression analyses are run on each industry group to identify the variables most strongly correlated to SVT. The benchmark industry SVT level is then adjusted upwards or downwards for the specific company by plugging the company-specific performance measures, size and cash compensation into the industry cap equations to arrive at the company’s allowable cap.

Repricing Provisions

Vote AGAINST plans that expressly permit the repricing or exchange of underwater stock options without prior shareholder approval, even if the cost of the plan is reasonable. Also, vote AGAINST OR WITHHOLD from members of the Compensation Committee who approved and/or implemented a repricing or an option exchange program, by buying out underwater options for stock, cash or other consideration or canceling underwater options and regranting options with a lower exercise price, without prior shareholder approval, even if such repricings are allowed in their equity plan.

Vote AGAINST plans if the company has a history of repricing options without shareholder approval, and the applicable listing standards would not preclude them from doing so.

 

B-64


Table of Contents

 

Three-Year Burn Rate/Burn Rate Commitment

Generally vote AGAINST equity plans for companies whose average three-year burn rates exceeds the greater of: (1) the mean plus one standard deviation of the company’s GICS group segmented by Russell 3000 index and non-Russell 3000 index (per the following Burn Rate Table); or (2) two percent of weighted common shares outstanding. The three-year burn rate policy does not apply to non-employee director plans unless outside directors receive a significant portion of shares each year.

The annual burn rate is calculated as follows:

Annual Burn rate = (# of options granted + # of full value shares awarded * Multiplier) / Weighted Average common shares outstanding)

However, vote FOR equity plans if the company fails this burn rate test but the company commits in a public filing to a three-year average burn rate equal to its GICS group burn rate mean plus one standard deviation (or 2%, whichever is greater), assuming all other conditions for voting FOR the plan have been met.

If a company fails to fulfill its burn rate commitment, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from the compensation committee.

For the Dec. 1, 2009 and future quarterly data downloads, RMG will use the 200-day volatility for the shareholder value transfer and burn rate policies. We will also use the 200-day average stock price for the shareholder value transfer policy.

Burn Rate Table for 2010

 

          Russell 3000     Non-Russell 3000  

GICS

  

Description

   Mean     Standard
Deviation
    Mean+
STDEV
    Mean     Standard
Deviation
    Mean+
STDEV
 

1010

   Energy      1.07     1.08     2.14     2.04     2.26     4.30

1510

   Materials      0.94     0.68     1.63     1.97     2.57     4.54

2010

   Capital Goods      1.10     0.85     1.95     2.07     2.62     4.69

2020

   Commercial Services & Supplies      1.67     1.23     2.89     1.82     1.71     3.53

2030

   Transportation      1.20     0.93     2.13     1.36     0.95     2.31

2510

   Automobiles & Components      1.36     1.63     2.99     1.36     1.63     2.99

2520

   Consumer Durables & Apparel      1.76     1.21     2.97     1.56     1.81     3.37

2530

   Hotels Restaurants & Leisure      1.69     1.11     2.80     1.52     1.65     3.17

2540

   Media      1.36     0.93     2.28     2.14     1.88     4.03

2550

   Retailing      1.69     1.41     3.10     2.19     1.82     4.01

3010,
3020, 3030

   Food & Staples Retailing      1.25     1.67     2.92     1.52     1.65     3.17

3510

   Health Care Equipment & Services      2.19     1.46     3.65     3.77     4.16     7.92

3520

   Pharmaceuticals & Biotechnology      3.19     1.97     5.16     4.52     4.05     8.58

4010

   Banks      1.02     1.04     2.05     0.81     1.31     2.12

4020

   Diversified Financials      2.21     2.94     5.15     4.25     4.05     8.30

4030

   Insurance      1.07     0.94     2.02     1.03     1.28     2.31

4040

   Real Estate      0.56     0.49     1.04     0.99     2.14     3.13

4510

   Software & Services      3.15     2.32     5.47     4.32     3.26     7.58

4520

   Technology Hardware & Equipment      2.60     2.18     4.79     3.32     3.76     7.08

4530

   Semiconductors & Semiconductor Equipment      2.94     1.88     4.82     4.33     2.98     7.31

5010

   Telecommunication Services      1.30     1.20     2.50     2.63     2.45     5.08

5510

   Utilities      0.41     0.39     0.80     0.76     0.88     1.64

 

B-65


Table of Contents

 

For companies that grant both full value awards and stock options to their participants, apply a premium on full value awards for the past three fiscal years. The guideline for applying the premium is as follows:

 

Stock Price Volatility

  

Multiplier

54.6% and higher

   1 full-value award will count as 1.5 option shares

36.1% or higher and less than 54.6%

   1 full-value award will count as 2.0 option shares

24.9% or higher and less than 36.1%

   1 full-value award will count as 2.5 option shares

16.5% or higher and less than 24.9%

   1 full-value award will count as 3.0 option shares

7.9% or higher and less than 16.5%

   1 full-value award will count as 3.5 option shares

Less than 7.9%

   1 full-value award will count as 4.0 option shares

Pay-for-Performance- Impact on Equity Plans

If a significant portion of the CEO’s misaligned pay is attributed to equity awards, and there is an equity plan on the ballot, vote AGAINST the equity plan, taking in to consideration:

 

   

Magnitude of pay increase/decrease in the last fiscal year;

 

   

Source of pay increase (cash or equity); and

 

   

Proportion of equity awards granted in the last fiscal year concentrated at the named executive officer level.

See Pay-for-Performance discussion under Executive Pay Evaluation for further details.

Liberal Definition of Change-in-Control

Generally vote AGAINST equity plans if the plan provides for the acceleration of vesting of equity awards even though an actual change in control may not occur. Examples of such a definition could include, but are not limited to, announcement or commencement of a tender offer, provisions for acceleration upon a “potential” takeover, shareholder approval of a merger or other transactions, or similar language.

Problematic Pay Practices

If the equity plan on the ballot is a vehicle for problematic pay practices, vote AGAINST the plan.

Specific Treatment of Certain Award Types in Equity Plan Evaluations:

Dividend Equivalent Rights

Options that have Dividend Equivalent Rights (DERs) associated with them will have a higher calculated award value than those without DERs under the binomial model, based on the value of these dividend streams. The higher value will be applied to new shares, shares available under existing plans, and shares awarded but not exercised per the plan specifications. DERS transfer more shareholder equity to employees and non-employee directors and this cost should be captured.

Liberal Share Recycling Provisions

Under net share counting provisions, shares tendered by an option holder to pay for the exercise of an option, shares withheld for taxes or shares repurchased by the company on the open market can be recycled back

 

B-66


Table of Contents

into the equity plan for awarding again. All awards with such provisions should be valued as full-value awards. Stock-settled stock appreciation rights (SSARs) will also be considered as full-value awards if a company counts only the net shares issued to employees towards their plan reserve.

Operating Partnership (OP) units in Equity Plan analysis of Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

For Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITS), include the common shares issuable upon conversion of outstanding Operating Partnership (OP) units in the share count for the purposes of determining: (1) market capitalization in the Shareholder Value Transfer (SVT) analysis and (2) shares outstanding in the burn rate analysis.

Option Overhang Cost

Companies with sustained positive stock performance and high overhang cost attributable to in-the-money options outstanding in excess of six years may warrant a carve-out of these options from the overhang as long as the dilution attributable to the new share request is reasonable and the company exhibits sound compensation practices. Consider, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, a carve-out of a portion of cost attributable to overhang, considering the following criteria:

 

   

Performance: Companies with sustained positive stock performance will merit greater scrutiny. Five-year total shareholder return (TSR), year-over-year performance, and peer performance could play a significant role in this determination.

 

   

Overhang Disclosure: Assess whether optionees have held in-the-money options for a prolonged period (thus reflecting their confidence in the prospects of the company). Note that this assessment would require additional disclosure regarding a company’s overhang. Specifically, the following disclosure would be required:

 

  The number of in-the-money options outstanding in excess of six or more years with a corresponding weighted average exercise price and weighted average contractual remaining term;
  The number of all options outstanding less than six years and underwater options outstanding in excess of six years with a corresponding weighted average exercise price and weighted average contractual remaining term;

 

  The general vesting provisions of option grants; and

 

  The distribution of outstanding option grants with respect to the named executive officers;

 

   

Dilution: Calculate the expected duration of the new share request in addition to all shares currently available for grant under the equity compensation program, based on the company’s three-year average burn rate (or a burn-rate commitment that the company makes for future years). The expected duration will be calculated by multiplying the company’s unadjusted (options and full-value awards accounted on a one-for-one basis) three-year average burn rate by the most recent fiscal year’s weighted average shares outstanding (as used in the company’s calculation of basic EPS) and divide the sum of the new share request and all available shares under the company’s equity compensation program by the product. For example, an expected duration in excess of five years could be considered problematic; and

 

   

Compensation Practices: An evaluation of overall practices could include: (1) stock option repricing provisions, (2) high concentration ratios (of grants to top executives), or (3) additional practices outlined in the Poor Pay Practices policy.

 

B-67


Table of Contents

 

Other Compensation Plans

401(k) Employee Benefit Plans

Vote FOR proposals to implement a 401(k) savings plan for employees.

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

Vote FOR proposals to implement an ESOP or increase authorized shares for existing ESOPs, unless the number of shares allocated to the ESOP is excessive (more than five percent of outstanding shares).

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Qualified Plans

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on qualified employee stock purchase plans. Vote FOR employee stock purchase plans where all of the following apply:

 

   

Purchase price is at least 85 percent of fair market value;

 

   

Offering period is 27 months or less; and

 

   

The number of shares allocated to the plan is ten percent or less of the outstanding shares.

Vote AGAINST qualified employee stock purchase plans where any of the following apply:

 

   

Purchase price is less than 85 percent of fair market value; or

 

   

Offering period is greater than 27 months; or

 

   

The number of shares allocated to the plan is more than ten percent of the outstanding shares.

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Non-Qualified Plans

Vote CASE-by-CASE on nonqualified employee stock purchase plans. Vote FOR nonqualified employee stock purchase plans with all the following features:

 

   

Broad-based participation (i.e., all employees of the company with the exclusion of individuals with 5 percent or more of beneficial ownership of the company);

 

   

Limits on employee contribution, which may be a fixed dollar amount or expressed as a percent of base salary;

 

   

Company matching contribution up to 25 percent of employee’s contribution, which is effectively a discount of 20 percent from market value;

 

   

No discount on the stock price on the date of purchase since there is a company matching contribution.

Vote AGAINST nonqualified employee stock purchase plans when any of the plan features do not meet the above criteria. If the company matching contribution exceeds 25 percent of employee’s contribution, evaluate the cost of the plan against its allowable cap.

Incentive Bonus Plans and Tax Deductibility Proposals (OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals)

Vote FOR proposals that simply amend shareholder-approved compensation plans to include administrative features or place a cap on the annual grants any one participant may receive to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code.

 

B-68


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR proposals to add performance goals to existing compensation plans to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) unless they are clearly inappropriate.

Votes to amend existing plans to increase shares reserved and to qualify for favorable tax treatment under the provisions of Section 162(m) are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis using a proprietary, quantitative model developed by RMG.

Generally vote FOR cash or cash and stock bonus plans that are submitted to shareholders for the purpose of exempting compensation from taxes under the provisions of Section 162(m) if no increase in shares is requested.

Vote AGAINST proposals if the compensation committee does not fully consist of independent outsiders, as defined in RMG’s classification of director independence.

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

Vote CASE-by-CASE on management proposals seeking approval to exchange/reprice options taking into consideration:

 

   

Historic trading patterns — the stock price should not be so volatile that the options are likely to be back “in-the-money” over the near term;

 

   

Rationale for the re-pricing — was the stock price decline beyond management’s control?

 

   

Is this a value-for-value exchange?

 

   

Are surrendered stock options added back to the plan reserve?

 

   

Option vesting — does the new option vest immediately or is there a black-out period?

 

   

Term of the option — the term should remain the same as that of the replaced option;

 

   

Exercise price — should be set at fair market or a premium to market;

 

   

Participants — executive officers and directors should be excluded.

If the surrendered options are added back to the equity plans for re-issuance, then also take into consideration the company’s total cost of equity plans and its three-year average burn rate.

In addition to the above considerations, evaluate the intent, rationale, and timing of the repricing proposal. The proposal should clearly articulate why the board is choosing to conduct an exchange program at this point in time. Repricing underwater options after a recent precipitous drop in the company’s stock price demonstrates poor timing. Repricing after a recent decline in stock price triggers additional scrutiny and a potential AGAINST vote on the proposal. At a minimum, the decline should not have happened within the past year. Also, consider the terms of the surrendered options, such as the grant date, exercise price and vesting schedule. Grant dates of surrendered options should be far enough back (two to three years) so as not to suggest that repricings are being done to take advantage of short-term downward price movements. Similarly, the exercise price of surrendered options should be above the 52-week high for the stock price.

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

Stock Plans in Lieu of Cash

Vote CASE-by-CASE on plans that provide participants with the option of taking all or a portion of their cash compensation in the form of stock.

 

B-69


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR non-employee director-only equity plans that provide a dollar-for-dollar cash-for-stock exchange.

Vote CASE-by-CASE on plans which do not provide a dollar-for-dollar cash for stock exchange. In cases where the exchange is not dollar-for-dollar, the request for new or additional shares for such equity program will be considered using the binomial option pricing model. In an effort to capture the total cost of total compensation, RMG will not make any adjustments to carve out the in-lieu-of cash compensation.

Transfer Stock Option (TSO) Programs

One-time Transfers: Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from compensation committee members if they fail to submit one-time transfers to shareholders for approval.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on one-time transfers. Vote FOR if:

 

   

Executive officers and non-employee directors are excluded from participating;

 

   

Stock options are purchased by third-party financial institutions at a discount to their fair value using option pricing models such as Black-Scholes or a Binomial Option Valuation or other appropriate financial models;

 

   

There is a two-year minimum holding period for sale proceeds (cash or stock) for all participants.

Additionally, management should provide a clear explanation of why options are being transferred to a third-party institution and whether the events leading up to a decline in stock price were beyond management’s control. A review of the company’s historic stock price volatility should indicate if the options are likely to be back “in-the-money” over the near term.

Ongoing TSO program: Vote AGAINST equity plan proposals if the details of ongoing TSO programs are not provided to shareholders. Since TSOs will be one of the award types under a stock plan, the ongoing TSO program, structure and mechanics must be disclosed to shareholders. The specific criteria to be considered in evaluating these proposals include, but not limited, to the following:

 

   

Eligibility;

 

   

Vesting;

 

   

Bid-price;

 

   

Term of options;

 

   

Cost of the program and impact of the TSOs on company’s total option expense

 

   

Option repricing policy.

Amendments to existing plans that allow for introduction of transferability of stock options should make clear that only options granted post-amendment shall be transferable.

Director Compensation

Equity Plans for Non-Employee Directors

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on compensation plans for non-employee directors, based on the cost of the plans against the company’s allowable cap.

 

B-70


Table of Contents

 

On occasion, director stock plans that set aside a relatively small number of shares when combined with employee or executive stock compensation plans will exceed the allowable cap. Vote for the plan if ALL of the following qualitative factors in the board’s compensation are met and disclosed in the proxy statement:

 

   

Director stock ownership guidelines with a minimum of three times the annual cash retainer.

 

   

Vesting schedule or mandatory holding/deferral period:

 

  A minimum vesting of three years for stock options or restricted stock; or

 

  Deferred stock payable at the end of a three-year deferral period.

 

   

Mix between cash and equity:

 

  A balanced mix of cash and equity, for example 40% cash/60% equity or 50% cash/50% equity; or

 

  If the mix is heavier on the equity component, the vesting schedule or deferral period should be more stringent, with the lesser of five years or the term of directorship.

 

   

No retirement/benefits and perquisites provided to non-employee directors; and

 

   

Detailed disclosure provided on cash and equity compensation delivered to each non-employee director for the most recent fiscal year in a table. The column headers for the table may include the following: name of each non-employee director, annual retainer, board meeting fees, committee retainer, committee-meeting fees, and equity grants.

Director Retirement Plans

Vote AGAINST retirement plans for non-employee directors.

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to eliminate retirement plans for non-employee directors.

Shareholder Proposals on Compensation

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay)

Generally, vote FOR shareholder proposals that call for non-binding shareholder ratification of the compensation of the Named Executive Officers and the accompanying narrative disclosure of material factors provided to understand the Summary Compensation Table.

Compensation Consultants- Disclosure of Board or Company’s utilization

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking disclosure regarding the Company, Board, or Compensation Committee’s use of compensation consultants, such as company name, business relationship(s) and fees paid.

Disclosure/Setting Levels or Types of Compensation for Executives and Directors

Generally, vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking additional disclosure of executive and director pay information, provided the information requested is relevant to shareholders’ needs, would not put the company at a competitive disadvantage relative to its industry, and is not unduly burdensome to the company.

 

B-71


Table of Contents

 

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals seeking to set absolute levels on compensation or otherwise dictate the amount or form of compensation.

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals requiring director fees be paid in stock only.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on all other shareholder proposals regarding executive and director pay, taking into account company performance, pay level versus peers, pay level versus industry, and long-term corporate outlook.

Golden Coffins/Executive Death Benefits

Generally vote FOR proposals calling companies to adopt a policy of obtaining shareholder approval for any future agreements and corporate policies that could oblige the company to make payments or awards following the death of a senior executive in the form of unearned salary or bonuses, accelerated vesting or the continuation in force of unvested equity grants, perquisites and other payments or awards made in lieu of compensation. This would not apply to any benefit programs or equity plan proposals that the broad-based employee population is eligible.

Pay for Superior Performance

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals based on a case-by-case analysis that requests the board establish a pay-for-superior performance standard in the company’s executive compensation plan for senior executives. The proposal has the following principles:

 

   

Sets compensation targets for the Plan’s annual and long-term for incentive the pay components at or below the peer group median;

 

   

Delivers a majority of the Plan’s target long-term compensation through performance-vested, not simply time-vested, equity awards;

 

   

Provides the strategic rationale and relative weightings of the financial and non-financial performance metrics or criteria used in the annual and performance-vested long-term incentive components of the plan;

 

   

Establishes performance targets for each plan financial metric relative to the performance of the company’s peer companies;

 

   

Limits payment under the annual and performance-vested long-term incentive components of the plan to when the company’s performance on its selected financial performance metrics exceeds peer group median performance.

Consider the following factors in evaluating this proposal:

 

   

What aspects of the company’s annual and long-term equity incentive programs are performance driven?

 

   

If the annual and long-term equity incentive programs are performance driven, are the performance criteria and hurdle rates disclosed to shareholders or are they benchmarked against a disclosed peer group?

 

   

Can shareholders assess the correlation between pay and performance based on the current disclosure?

 

   

What type of industry and stage of business cycle does the company belong to?

 

B-72


Table of Contents

 

Performance-Based Awards

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposal requesting that a significant amount of future long-term incentive compensation awarded to senior executives shall be performance-based and requesting that the board adopt and disclose challenging performance metrics to shareholders, based on the following analytical steps:

 

   

First, vote FOR shareholder proposals advocating the use of performance-based equity awards, such as performance contingent options or restricted stock, indexed options or premium-priced options, unless the proposal is overly restrictive or if the company has demonstrated that it is using a “substantial” portion of performance-based awards for its top executives. Standard stock options and performance-accelerated awards do not meet the criteria to be considered as performance-based awards. Further, premium-priced options should have a premium of at least 25 percent and higher to be considered performance-based awards.

 

   

Second, assess the rigor of the company’s performance-based equity program. If the bar set for the performance-based program is too low based on the company’s historical or peer group comparison, generally vote FOR the proposal. Furthermore, if target performance results in an above target payout, vote FOR the shareholder proposal due to program’s poor design. If the company does not disclose the performance metric of the performance-based equity program, vote FOR the shareholder proposal regardless of the outcome of the first step to the test.

In general, vote FOR the shareholder proposal if the company does not meet both of the above two steps.

Pension Plan Income Accounting

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals to exclude pension plan income in the calculation of earnings used in determining executive bonuses/compensation.

Pre-Arranged Trading Plans (10b5-1 Plans)

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for certain principles regarding the use of prearranged trading plans (10b5-1 plans) for executives. These principles include:

 

   

Adoption, amendment, or termination of a 10b5-1 Plan must be disclosed within two business days in a Form 8-K;

 

   

Amendment or early termination of a 10b5-1 Plan is allowed only under extraordinary circumstances, as determined by the board;

 

   

Ninety days must elapse between adoption or amendment of a 10b5-1 Plan and initial trading under the plan;

 

   

Reports on Form 4 must identify transactions made pursuant to a 10b5-1 Plan;

 

   

An executive may not trade in company stock outside the 10b5-1 Plan.

 

   

Trades under a 10b5-1 Plan must be handled by a broker who does not handle other securities transactions for the executive.

Recoup Bonuses

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to recoup unearned incentive bonuses or other incentive payments made to senior executives if it is later determined that the figures upon which incentive compensation is earned

 

B-73


Table of Contents

later turn out to have been in error. This is line with the clawback provision in the Trouble Asset Relief Program. Many companies have adopted policies that permit recoupment in cases where fraud, misconduct, or negligence significantly contributed to a restatement of financial results that led to the awarding of unearned incentive compensation. RMG will take into consideration:

 

   

If the company has adopted a formal recoupment bonus policy;

 

   

If the company has chronic restatement history or material financial problems; or

 

   

If the company’s policy substantially addresses the concerns raised by the proponent.

Severance Agreements for Executives/Golden Parachutes

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requiring that golden parachutes or executive severance agreements be submitted for shareholder ratification, unless the proposal requires shareholder approval prior to entering into employment contracts.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on proposals to ratify or cancel golden parachutes. An acceptable parachute should include, but is not limited to, the following:

 

   

The triggering mechanism should be beyond the control of management;

 

   

The amount should not exceed three times base amount (defined as the average annual taxable W-2 compensation during the five years prior to the year in which the change of control occurs;

 

   

Change-in-control payments should be double-triggered, i.e., (1) after a change in control has taken place, and (2) termination of the executive as a result of the change in control. Change in control is defined as a change in the company ownership structure.

Share Buyback Holding Periods

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals prohibiting executives from selling shares of company stock during periods in which the company has announced that it may or will be repurchasing shares of its stock. Vote FOR the proposal when there is a pattern of abuse by executives exercising options or selling shares during periods of share buybacks.

Stock Ownership or Holding Period Guidelines

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board. While RMG favors stock ownership on the part of directors, the company should determine the appropriate ownership requirement.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking companies to adopt policies requiring Named Executive Officers to retain 75% of the shares acquired through compensation plans while employed and/or for two years following the termination of their employment, and to report to shareholders regarding this policy. The following factors will be taken into account:

 

   

Whether the company has any holding period, retention ratio, or officer ownership requirements in place. These should consist of:

 

  Rigorous stock ownership guidelines, or

 

B-74


Table of Contents

 

  A holding period requirement coupled with a significant long-term ownership requirement, or

 

  A meaningful retention ratio,

 

   

Actual officer stock ownership and the degree to which it meets or exceed the proponent’s suggested holding period/retention ratio or the company’s own stock ownership or retention requirements.

 

   

Problematic pay practices, current and past, which may promote a short-term versus a long-term focus.

A rigorous stock ownership guideline should be at least 10x base salary for the CEO, with the multiple declining for other executives. A meaningful retention ratio should constitute at least 50 percent of the stock received from equity awards (on a net proceeds basis) held on a long-term basis, such as the executive’s tenure with the company or even a few years past the executive’s termination with the company.

Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans (SERPs)

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting to put extraordinary benefits contained in SERP agreements to a shareholder vote unless the company’s executive pension plans do not contain excessive benefits beyond what is offered under employee-wide plans.

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting to limit the executive benefits provided under the company’s supplemental executive retirement plan (SERP) by limiting covered compensation to a senior executive’s annual salary and excluding of all incentive or bonus pay from the plan’s definition of covered compensation used to establish such benefits.

Termination of Employment Prior to Severance Payment and Eliminating Accelerated Vesting of Unvested Equity

Vote on a CASE-by-CASE on shareholder proposals seeking a policy requiring termination of employment prior to severance payment, and eliminating accelerated vesting of unvested equity. Change-in-control payouts without loss of job or substantial diminution of job duties (single-triggered) are consider a poor pay practice under RMG policy, and may even result in withheld votes from compensation committee members. The second component of this proposal – related to the elimination of accelerated vesting — requires more careful consideration. The following factors will be taken into regarding this policy.

 

   

The company’s current treatment of equity in change-of-control situations of (i. e. is it double triggered, does it allow for the assumption of equity by acquiring company, the treatment of performance shares.

 

   

Current employment agreements, including potential poor pay practices such as gross-ups embedded in those agreements.

Tax Gross-Up Proposals

Generally vote FOR proposals calling for companies to adopt a policy of not providing tax gross-up payments to executives, except in situations where gross-ups are provided pursuant to a plan, policy, or arrangement applicable to management employees of the company, such as a relocation or expatriate tax equalization policy.

 

B-75


Table of Contents

 

6. Social/Environmental Issues

Overall Approach

When evaluating social and environmental shareholder proposals, RMG considers the following factors:

 

   

Whether adoption of the proposal is likely to enhance or protect shareholder value;

 

   

Whether the information requested concerns business issues that relate to a meaningful percentage of the company’s business as measured by sales, assets, and earnings;

 

   

The degree to which the company’s stated position on the issues raised in the proposal could affect its reputation or sales, or leave it vulnerable to a boycott or selective purchasing;

 

   

Whether the issues presented are more appropriately/effectively dealt with through governmental or company-specific action;

 

   

Whether the company has already responded in some appropriate manner to the request embodied in the proposal;

 

   

Whether the company’s analysis and voting recommendation to shareholders are persuasive;

 

   

What other companies have done in response to the issue addressed in the proposal;

 

   

Whether the proposal itself is well framed and the cost of preparing the report is reasonable;

 

   

Whether implementation of the proposal’s request would achieve the proposal’s objectives;

 

   

Whether the subject of the proposal is best left to the discretion of the board;

 

   

Whether the requested information is available to shareholders either from the company or from a publicly available source; and

 

   

Whether providing this information would reveal proprietary or confidential information that would place the company at a competitive disadvantage.

Animal Welfare

Animal Testing

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to phase out the use of animals in product testing unless:

 

   

The company is conducting animal testing programs that are unnecessary or not required by regulation;

 

   

The company is conducting animal testing when suitable alternatives are commonly accepted and used at industry peers; or

 

   

There are recent, significant fines or litigation related to the company’s treatment of animals.

Animal Welfare Policies

Generally vote FOR proposals seeking a report on the company’s animal welfare standards unless:

 

   

The company has already published a set of animal welfare standards and monitors compliance;

 

   

The company’s standards are comparable to industry peer; and

 

   

There are no recent, significant fines or litigation related to the company’s treatment of animals.

 

B-76


Table of Contents

 

Controlled Atmosphere Killing (CAK)

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting the implementation of CAK methods at company and/or supplier operations unless such methods are required by legislation or generally accepted as the industry standard.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals requesting a report on the feasibility of implementing CAK methods at company and/or supplier operations considering the availability of existing research conducted by the company or industry groups on this topic and any fines or litigation related to current animal processing procedures at the company.

Consumer Issues

Genetically Modified Ingredients

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking suppliers, genetic research companies, restaurants and food retail companies to voluntarily label genetically engineered (GE) ingredients in their products and/or eliminate GE ingredients. The cost of labeling and/or phasing out the use of GE ingredients may not be commensurate with the benefits to shareholders and is an issue better left to regulators.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals asking for a report on the feasibility of labeling products containing GE ingredients taking into account:

 

   

The company’s business and the proportion of it affected by the resolution;

 

   

The quality of the company’s disclosure on GE product labeling, related voluntary initiatives, and how this disclosure compares with industry peer disclosure; and

 

   

Company’s current disclosure on the including feasibility or GE product labeling, including information on the related costs.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals seeking a report on the social, health, and environmental effects of genetically modified organisms (GMOs). Studies of this sort are better undertaken by regulators and the scientific community.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to completely phase out GE ingredients from the company’s products or proposals asking for reports outlining the steps necessary to eliminate GE ingredients from the company’s products. Such resolutions presuppose that there are proven health risks to GE ingredients (an issue better left to regulators) that may outweigh the economic benefits derived from biotechnology.

Consumer Lending

Vote CASE-BY CASE on requests for reports on the company’s lending guidelines and procedures taking into account:

 

   

Whether the company has adequately disclosed mechanisms in place to prevent abusive lending practices;

 

   

Whether the company has adequately disclosed the financial risks of the lending products in question;

 

   

Whether the company has been subject to violations of lending laws or serious lending controversies;

 

   

Peer companies’ policies to prevent abusive lending practices.

 

B-77


Table of Contents

 

Pharmaceutical Pricing, Access to Medicines, and Product Reimportation

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting that companies implement specific price restraints on pharmaceutical products unless the company fails to adhere to legislative guidelines or industry norms in its product pricing.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals requesting that the company evaluate report on their product pricing policies or their access to medicine policies, considering:

 

   

The nature of the company’s business and the potential for reputational and market risk exposure;

 

   

The existing disclosure of relevant policies;

 

   

Deviation from established industry norms;

 

   

The company’s existing, relevant initiatives to provide research and/or products to disadvantaged consumers;

 

   

Whether the proposal focuses on specific products or geographic regions; and

 

   

The potential cost and scope of the requested report.

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting that companies report on the financial and legal impact of their prescription drug reimportation policies unless such information is already publicly disclosed.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting that companies adopt specific policies to encourage or constrain prescription drug reimportation. Such matters are more appropriately the province of legislative activity and may place the company at a competitive disadvantage relative to its peers.

Product Safety and Toxic/Hazardous Materials

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting the company to report on its policies, initiatives/procedures, and oversight mechanisms related to toxic/hazardous materials or product safety in its supply chain, unless:

 

   

The company already discloses similar information through existing reports such as a Supplier Code of Conduct and/or a sustainability report;

 

   

The company has formally committed to the implementation of a toxic/hazardous materials and/or product safety and supply chain reporting and monitoring program based on industry norms or similar standards within a specified time frame; and

 

   

The company has not been recently involved in relevant significant controversies, significant fines, or litigation.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions requesting that companies develop a feasibility assessment to phase-out of certain toxic/hazardous materials, or evaluate and disclose the potential financial and legal risks associated with utilizing certain materials, considering:

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure regarding its product safety policies, initiatives and oversight mechanisms.

 

   

Current regulations in the markets in which the company operates; and

 

   

Recent significant controversies, litigation, or fines stemming from toxic/hazardous materials at the company.

Generally vote AGAINST resolutions requiring that a company reformulate its products.

 

B-78


Table of Contents

 

Tobacco

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions regarding the advertisement of tobacco products, considering:

 

   

Recent related fines, controversies, or significant litigation;

 

   

Whether the company complies with relevant laws and regulations on the marketing of tobacco;

 

   

Whether the company’s advertising restrictions deviate from those of industry peers;

 

   

Whether the company entered into the Master Settlement Agreement, which restricts marketing of tobacco to youth;

 

   

Whether restrictions on marketing to youth extend to foreign countries.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding second-hand smoke, considering;

 

   

Whether the company complies with all laws and regulations;

 

   

The degree that voluntary restrictions beyond those mandated by law might hurt the company’s competitiveness;

 

   

The risk of any health-related liabilities.

Generally vote AGAINST resolutions to cease production of tobacco-related products, to avoid selling products to tobacco companies, to spin-off tobacco-related businesses, or prohibit investment in tobacco equities. Such business decisions are better left to company management or portfolio managers.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals regarding tobacco product warnings. Such decisions are better left to public health authorities.

Diversity

Board Diversity

Generally vote FOR requests for reports on the company’s efforts to diversify the board, unless:

 

   

The gender and racial minority representation of the company’s board is reasonably inclusive in relation to companies of similar size and business; and

 

   

The board already reports on its nominating procedures and gender and racial minority initiatives on the board and within the company.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals asking the company to increase the gender and racial minority representation on its board, taking into account:

 

   

The degree of existing gender and racial minority diversity on the company’s board and among its executive officers;

 

   

The level of gender and racial minority representation that exists at the company’s industry peers;

 

   

The company’s established process for addressing gender and racial minority board representation;

 

   

Whether the proposal includes an overly prescriptive request to amend nominating committee charter language;

 

   

The independence of the company’s nominating committee;

 

   

The company uses an outside search firm to identify potential director nominees; and

 

B-79


Table of Contents

 

   

Whether the company has had recent controversies, fines, or litigation regarding equal employment practices.

Equality of Opportunity

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting a company disclose its diversity policies or initiatives, or proposals requesting disclosure of a company’s comprehensive workforce diversity data, including requests for EEO-1 data, unless:

 

   

The company publicly discloses its comprehensive equal opportunity policies and initiatives;

 

   

The company already publicly discloses comprehensive workforce diversity data; and

 

   

The company has no recent significant EEO-related violations or litigation.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals seeking information on the diversity efforts of suppliers and service providers. Such requests may pose a significant cost and administration burden on the company.

Gender Identity, Sexual Orientation, and Domestic Partner Benefits

Generally vote FOR proposals seeking to amend a company’s EEO statement or diversity policies to prohibit discrimination based on sexual orientation and/or gender identity, unless the change would result in excessive costs for the company.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to extend company benefits to, or eliminate benefits from domestic partners. Decisions regarding benefits should be left to the discretion of the company.

Climate Change and the Environment

Climate Change

Generally vote FOR resolutions requesting that a company disclose information on the impact of climate change on the company’s operations and investments considering:

 

   

The company already provides current, publicly-available information on the impacts that climate change may have on the company as well as associated company policies and procedures to address related risks and/or opportunities;

 

   

The company’s disclosure level of disclosure is at least of comparable to that of industry peers; and

 

   

There are no significant, controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company’s environmental performance.

Concentrated Animal Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

Generally vote FOR resolutions requesting companies report to shareholders on the risks and liabilities associated with CAFOs unless:

 

   

The company has publicly disclosed its environmental management policies for its corporate and contract farming operations, including compliance monitoring; and The company publicly discloses company and supplier farm environmental performance data; or

 

B-80


Table of Contents

 

   

The company does not have company-owned CAFOs and does not directly source from contract farm CAFOs.

Energy Efficiency

Generally vote FOR on proposals requesting a company report on its comprehensive energy efficiency policies, unless:

 

   

The company complies with applicable energy efficiency regulations and laws, and discloses its participation in energy efficiency policies and programs, including disclosure of benchmark data, targets, and performance measures; or

 

   

The proponent requests adoption of specific energy efficiency goals within specific timelines.

Facility and Operational Safety/Security

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions requesting that companies report on safety and/or security risks associated with their operations and/or facilities, considering:

 

   

The company’s compliance with applicable regulations and guidelines;

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure regarding its security and safety policies, procedures, and compliance monitoring; and,

 

   

The existence of recent, significant violations, fines, or controversy regarding the safety and security of the company’s operations and/or facilities.

Greenhouse Gas (GHG) Emissions

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting a report on greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions from company operations and/or products and operations, unless:

 

   

The company already provides current, publicly-available information on the impacts that GHG emissions may have on the company as well as associated company policies and procedures to address related risks and/or opportunities;

 

   

The company’s level of disclosure is comparable to that of industry peers; and

 

   

There are no significant, controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company’s GHG emissions.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals that call for the adoption of GHG reduction goals from products and operations, taking into account:

 

   

Overly prescriptive requests for the reduction in GHG emissions by specific amounts or within a specific time frame;

 

   

Whether company disclosure lags behind industry peers;

 

   

Whether the company has been the subject of recent, significant violations, fines, litigation, or controversy related to GHG emissions;

 

   

The feasibility of reduction of GHGs given the company’s product line and current technology and;

 

B-81


Table of Contents

 

   

Whether the company already provides meaningful disclosure on GHG emissions from its products and operations.

Operations in Protected Areas

Generally vote FOR requests for reports on potential environmental damage as a result of company operations in protected regions unless:

 

   

Operations in the specified regions are not permitted by current laws or regulations;

 

   

The company does not currently have operations or plans to develop operations in these protected regions; or,

 

   

The company’s disclosure of its operations and environmental policies in these regions is comparable to industry peers.

Recycling

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to adopt a comprehensive recycling strategy, taking into account:

 

   

The nature of the company’s business;

 

   

The extent that peer companies are recycling;

 

   

The timetable prescribed by the proposal and the costs and methods of implementation;

 

   

Whether the company has a poor environmental track record, such as violations of applicable regulations.

Renewable Energy

Generally vote FOR requests for reports on the feasibility of developing renewable energy resources unless the report is duplicative of existing disclosure or irrelevant to the company’s line of business.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting that the company invest in renewable energy resources. Such decisions are best left to management’s evaluation of the feasibility and financial impact that such programs may have on the company.

General Corporate Issues

Charitable Contributions

Vote AGAINST proposals restricting the company from making charitable contributions. Charitable contributions are generally useful for assisting worthwhile causes and for creating goodwill in the community. In the absence of bad faith, self-dealing, or gross negligence, management should determine which, and if, contributions are in the best interests of the company.

 

B-82


Table of Contents

 

Environmental, Social, and Governance (ESG) Compensation-Related Proposals

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to link, or report on linking, executive compensation to environmental and social criteria (such as corporate downsizings, customer or employee satisfaction, community involvement, human rights, environmental performance, or predatory lending) as the practice of linking executive compensation and such criteria is currently the exception rather than the norm and there appears to be a lack of widely-accepted standards regarding the implementation of effective linkages between executive compensation and corporate non-financial performance. However, the following factors will be considered:

 

   

Whether the company has significant and persistent controversies or violations regarding social and/or environmental issues;

 

   

Whether the company has management systems and oversight mechanisms in place regarding its social and environmental performance;

 

   

The degree to which industry peers have incorporated similar non-financial performance criteria in their executive compensation practices; and

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure regarding its environmental and social performance.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals calling for an analysis of the pay disparity between corporate executives and other non-executive employees. The value of the information sought by such proposals is unclear.

Health Pandemics

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on requests for reports outlining the impact of health pandemics (such as HIV/AIDS, Malaria, Tuberculosis, and Avian Flu) on the company’s operations and how the company is responding to the situation, taking into account:

 

   

The scope of the company’s operations in the affected/relevant area(s);

 

   

The company’s existing healthcare policies, including benefits and healthcare access; and

 

   

Company donations to relevant healthcare providers.

Vote AGAINST proposals asking companies to establish, implement, and report on a standard of response to health pandemics (such as HIV/AIDS, Malaria, Tuberculosis, and Avian Flu), unless the company has significant operations in the affected markets and has failed to adopt policies and/or procedures to address these issues comparable to those of industry peers.

Lobbying Expenditures/Initiatives

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals requesting information on a company’s lobbying initiatives, considering:

 

   

Significant controversies, fines, or litigation surrounding a company’s public policy activities,

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure on lobbying strategy, and

 

   

The impact that the policy issue may have on the company’s business operations.

 

B-83


Table of Contents

 

Political Contributions and Trade Associations Spending

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking the company to affirm political nonpartisanship in the workplace so long as:

 

   

There are no recent, significant controversies, fines or litigation regarding the company’s political contributions or trade association spending; and

 

   

The company has procedures in place to ensure that employee contributions to company-sponsored political action committees (PACs) are strictly voluntary and prohibits coercion.

Vote AGAINST proposals to publish in newspapers and public media the company’s political contributions. Such publications could present significant cost to the company without providing commensurate value to shareholders.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to improve the disclosure of a company’s political contributions and trade association spending considering:

 

   

Recent significant controversy or litigation related to the company’s political contributions or governmental affairs; and

 

   

The public availability of a company policy on political contributions and trade association spending including information on the types of organizations supported, the business rationale for supporting these organizations, and the oversight and compliance procedures related to such expenditures of corporate assets.

Vote AGAINST proposals barring the company from making political contributions. Businesses are affected by legislation at the federal, state, and local level and barring political contributions can put the company at a competitive disadvantage.

Vote AGAINST proposals asking for a list of company executives, directors, consultants, legal counsels, lobbyists, or investment bankers that have prior government service and whether such service had a bearing on the business of the company. Such a list would be burdensome to prepare without providing any meaningful information to shareholders.

International Issues, Labor Issues, and Human Rights

Community Social and Environmental Impact Assessments

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on requests for reports outlining policies and/or the potential (community) social and/or environmental impact of company operations considering:

 

   

Current disclosure of applicable policies and risk assessment report(s) and risk management procedures;

 

   

The impact of regulatory non-compliance, litigation, remediation, or reputational loss that may be associated with failure to manage the company’s operations in question, including the management of relevant community and stakeholder relations;

 

   

The nature, purpose, and scope of the company’s operations in the specific region(s);

 

   

The degree to which company policies and procedures are consistent with industry norms; and

 

   

Scope of the resolution.

 

B-84


Table of Contents

 

Foreign Military Sales/Offsets

Vote AGAINST reports on foreign military sales or offsets. Such disclosures may involve sensitive and confidential information. Moreover, companies must comply with government controls and reporting on foreign military sales.

Internet Privacy and Censorship

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions requesting the disclosure and implementation of Internet privacy and censorship policies and procedures considering:

 

   

The level of disclosure of company policies and procedures relating to privacy, freedom of speech, Internet censorship, and government monitoring of the Internet;

 

   

Engagement in dialogue with governments and/or relevant groups with respect to the Internet and the free flow of information;

 

   

The scope of business involvement and of investment in markets that maintain government censorship or monitoring of the Internet;

 

   

The market-specific laws or regulations applicable to Internet censorship or monitoring that may be imposed on the company; and,

 

   

The level of controversy or litigation related to the company’s international human rights policies and procedures.

Labor and Human Rights Standards

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting a report on company or company supplier labor and/or human rights standards and policies unless such information is already publicly disclosed.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to implement company or company supplier labor and/or human rights standards and policies, considering:

 

   

The degree to which existing relevant policies and practices are disclosed;

 

   

Whether or not existing relevant policies are consistent with internationally recognized standards;

 

   

Whether company facilities and those of its suppliers are monitored and how;

 

   

Company participation in fair labor organizations or other internationally recognized human rights initiatives;

 

   

Scope and nature of business conducted in markets known to have higher risk of workplace labor/human rights abuse;

 

   

Recent, significant company controversies, fines, or litigation regarding human rights at the company or its suppliers;

 

   

The scope of the request; and

 

   

Deviation from industry sector peer company standards and practices.

 

B-85


Table of Contents

 

MacBride Principles

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to endorse or increase activity on the MacBride Principles, unless:

 

   

The company has formally been found to be out of compliance with relevant Northern Ireland fair employment laws and regulations;

 

   

Failure to implement the MacBride Principles would put the company in an inconsistent position and/or at a competitive disadvantage compared with industry peers;

 

   

Failure to implement the MacBride Principles would subject the company to excessively negative financial impacts due to laws that some municipalities have passed regarding their contracting operations and companies that have not implemented the MacBride Principles; or

 

   

The company has had recent, significant controversies, fines or litigation regarding religious-based employment discrimination in Northern Ireland.

Nuclear and Depleted Uranium Weapons

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking a company to cease production or report on the risks associated with the use of depleted uranium munitions or nuclear weapons components and delivery systems, including disengaging from current and proposed contracts. Such contracts are monitored by government agencies, serve multiple military and non-military uses, and withdrawal from these contracts could have a negative impact on the company’s business.

     

Operations in High Risk Markets

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on requests for a report on a company’s potential financial reputational risks associated with operations in “high-risk” markets, such as a terrorism-sponsoring state or politically/socially unstable region, taking into account:

 

   

The nature, purpose, and scope of the operations and business involved that could be affected by social or political disruption;

 

   

Current disclosure of applicable risk assessment(s) and risk management procedures;

 

   

Compliance with U.S. sanctions and laws;

 

   

Consideration of other international policies, standards, and laws; and

 

   

Whether the company has been recently involved in recent, significant controversies, fines or litigation related to its operations in “high-risk” markets.

     

Outsourcing/Offshoring

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals calling for companies to report on the risks associated with outsourcing/plant closures, considering:

 

   

Controversies surrounding operations in the relevant market(s);

 

   

The value of the requested report to shareholders;

 

B-86


Table of Contents

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure of relevant information on outsourcing and plant closure procedures; and

 

   

The company’s existing human rights standards relative to industry peers.

     

Sustainability

Sustainability Reporting

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting the company to report on its policies, initiatives, and oversight mechanisms related to social, economic, and environmental sustainability, unless:

 

   

The company already discloses similar information through existing reports or policies such as an Environment, Health, and Safety (EHS) report; a comprehensive Code of Corporate Conduct; and/or a Diversity Report; or

 

   

The company has formally committed to the implementation of a reporting program based on Global Reporting Initiative (GRI) guidelines or a similar standard within a specified time frame

     

7. Mutual Fund Proxies

Election of Directors

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the election of directors and trustees, following the same guidelines for uncontested directors for public company shareholder meetings. However, mutual fund boards do not usually have compensation committees, so do not withhold for the lack of this committee.

     

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on conversion proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance as a closed-end fund;

 

   

Market in which the fund invests;

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the discount; and

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals.

     

Proxy Contests

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proxy contests, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance relative to its peers;

 

   

Market in which fund invests;

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the issues;

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals;

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents;

 

B-87


Table of Contents
   

Independence of directors;

 

   

Experience and skills of director candidates;

 

   

Governance profile of the company;

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment.

     

Investment Advisory Agreements

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on investment advisory agreements, considering the following factors:

 

   

Proposed and current fee schedules;

 

   

Fund category/investment objective;

 

   

Performance benchmarks;

 

   

Share price performance as compared with peers;

 

   

Resulting fees relative to peers;

 

   

Assignments (where the advisor undergoes a change of control).

     

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares

Vote FOR the establishment of new classes or series of shares.

     

Preferred Stock Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the authorization for or increase in preferred shares, considering the following factors:

 

   

Stated specific financing purpose;

 

   

Possible dilution for common shares;

 

   

Whether the shares can be used for antitakeover purposes.

     

1940 Act Policies

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on policies under the Investment Advisor Act of 1940, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness;

 

   

Regulatory developments;

 

   

Current and potential returns; and

 

   

Current and potential risk.

Generally vote FOR these amendments as long as the proposed changes do not fundamentally alter the investment focus of the fund and do comply with the current SEC interpretation.

     

 

B-88


Table of Contents

 

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Nonfundamental Restriction

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to change a fundamental restriction to a non-fundamental restriction, considering the following factors:

 

   

The fund’s target investments;

 

   

The reasons given by the fund for the change; and

 

   

The projected impact of the change on the portfolio.

     

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Nonfundamental

Vote AGAINST proposals to change a fund’s fundamental investment objective to non-fundamental.

     

Name Change Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on name change proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Political/economic changes in the target market;

 

   

Consolidation in the target market; and

 

   

Current asset composition.

     

Change in Fund’s Subclassification

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on changes in a fund’s sub-classification, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness;

 

   

Current and potential returns;

 

   

Risk of concentration;

 

   

Consolidation in target industry.

     

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to dispose of assets, to terminate or liquidate, considering the following factors:

 

   

Strategies employed to salvage the company;

 

   

The fund’s past performance;

 

   

The terms of the liquidation.

     

 

B-89


Table of Contents

 

Changes to the Charter Document

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on changes to the charter document, considering the following factors:

 

   

The degree of change implied by the proposal;

 

   

The efficiencies that could result;

 

   

The state of incorporation;

 

   

Regulatory standards and implications.

Vote AGAINST any of the following changes:

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to reorganize or terminate the trust or any of its series;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement for amendments to the new declaration of trust;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to amend the fund’s management contract, allowing the contract to be modified by the investment manager and the trust management, as permitted by the 1940 Act;

 

   

Allow the trustees to impose other fees in addition to sales charges on investment in a fund, such as deferred sales charges and redemption fees that may be imposed upon redemption of a fund’s shares;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to engage in and terminate subadvisory arrangements;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to change the domicile of the fund.

     

Changing the Domicile of a Fund

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on re-incorporations, considering the following factors:

 

   

Regulations of both states;

 

   

Required fundamental policies of both states;

 

   

The increased flexibility available.

     

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval

Vote AGAINST proposals authorizing the board to hire/terminate subadvisors without shareholder approval.

     

Distribution Agreements

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on distribution agreement proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fees charged to comparably sized funds with similar objectives;

 

   

The proposed distributor’s reputation and past performance;

 

   

The competitiveness of the fund in the industry;

 

   

The terms of the agreement.

     

 

B-90


Table of Contents

 

Master-Feeder Structure

Vote FOR the establishment of a master-feeder structure.

     

Mergers

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on merger proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Resulting fee structure;

 

   

Performance of both funds;

 

   

Continuity of management personnel;

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights.

     

Shareholder Proposals for Mutual Funds

Establish Director Ownership Requirement

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a specific minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board.

    

Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses. When supporting the dissidents, vote FOR the reimbursement of the proxy solicitation expenses.

     

Terminate the Investment Advisor

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to terminate the investment advisor, considering the following factors:

 

   

Performance of the fund’s Net Asset Value (NAV);

 

   

The fund’s history of shareholder relations;

 

   

The performance of other funds under the advisor’s management.

     

 

B-91


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

[LOGO] 

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

RMG Governance Services

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

Copyright © 2009 by RiskMetrics Group. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.


Table of Contents

 

General Policies

 

Financial Results/Director and Auditor Reports

     B-94   

Appointment of Auditors and Auditor Compensation

     B-95   

Appointment of Internal Statutory Auditors

     B-96   

Allocation of Income

     B-97   

Amendments to Articles of Association

     B-99   

Change in Company Fiscal Term

     B-100   

Lower Disclosure Threshold for Stock Ownership

     B-101   

Amend Quorum Requirements

     B-102   

Transact Other Business

     B-103   

International Classification of Directors

     B-107   

Director Compensation

     B-109   

Director, Officer, and Auditor Indemnification and Liability Provisions

     B-112   

Board Structure

     B-113   

Capital Systems

     B-115   

Reduction of Capital

     B-119   

Capital Structures

     B-121   

Preferred Stock

     B-122   

Debt Issuance Requests

     B-124   

Pledging of Assets for Debt

     B-125   

Increase in Borrowing Powers

     B-126   

Reissuance of Shares Repurchased

     B-128   

Capitalization of Reserves for Bonus Issues/Increase In Par Value

     B-129   

Reorganizations/Restructurings

     B-130   

Mergers and Acquisitions

     B-131   

Mandatory Takeover Bid Waivers

     B-133   

Reincorporation Proposals

     B-134   

Expansion of Business Activities

     B-135   

Related-Party Transactions

     B-136   

Antitakeover Mechanisms

     B-145   

Shareholder Proposals

     B-146   

Compensation Systems — Europe

  

Election of Former CEO as Chairman of the Board — Europe

  

 

B-93


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Financial Results/Director and Auditor Reports

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR approval of financial statements and director and auditor reports, unless:

 

   

There are concerns about the accounts presented or audit procedures used; or

 

   

The company is not responsive to shareholder questions about specific items that should be publicly disclosed.

Discussion

Most companies around the world submit these reports to shareholders for approval, and this is one of the first items on most agendas. The official financial statements and director and auditor reports are valuable documents when evaluating a company’s annual performance. The director report usually includes a review of the company’s performance during the year, justification of dividend levels and profits or losses, special events such as acquisitions or disposals, and future plans for the company.

The auditor report discloses any irregularities or problems with the company’s finances. While a qualified report by itself is not sufficient reason to oppose this resolution, it raises cautionary flags of which shareholders should be aware. Most auditor reports are unqualified, meaning that in the auditor’s opinion, the company’s financial statements are made in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

When evaluating a company’s financial statements, RMG looks at debt/equity levels on the balance sheet, historical sales and earnings performance, dividend history and payout ratios, and the company’s performance within its own country and relative to similar companies in its industry. Unless there are major concerns about the accuracy of the financial statements or the director or auditor reports, RMG recommends approval of this item.

 

B-94


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Appointment of Auditors and Auditor Compensation

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR the reelection of auditors and proposals authorizing the board to fix auditor fees, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the accounts presented or the audit procedures used;

 

 

   

The auditors are being changed without explanation; or

 

 

   

Non-audit-related fees are substantial or are routinely in excess of standard annual audit-related fees.

 

Vote AGAINST the appointment of external auditors if they have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company.

Discussion

Most major companies around the world use one of the major international auditing firms to conduct their audits. As such, concerns about the quality and objectivity of the audit are minimal, and the reappointment of the auditor is usually a routine matter. Audit fees tend to be highly competitive and vary little between companies. However, if a company proposes a new auditor or an auditor resigns and does not seek reelection, companies should offer an explanation to shareholders. If shareholders request an explanation for a change in auditor and the company or retiring auditor fails to provide one, RMG recommends a vote against the election of a new auditor. If an explanation is otherwise unavailable, RMG recommends that shareholders abstain on this item.

Many countries also require the appointment of censors, or special auditors who ensure that the board and management are in compliance with the company’s articles. The censors’ role is purely advisory in nature. Proposals to appoint censors are routine, as the censors usually act as a secondary auditor for special audit requirements.

The practice of auditors providing non-audit services to companies is problematic. While large auditors may have effective internal barriers to ensure that there are no conflicts of interest, an auditor’s ability to remain objective becomes questionable when fees paid to the auditor for non-audit services such as management consulting, general bookkeeping, and special situation audits exceed the standard annual audit fees. While some compensation for non-audit services is customary, the importance of maintaining the independence of the auditor is paramount. If fees from non-audit services become significant without any clear safeguards against conflicts of interest, RMG recommends opposing the auditor’s reappointment.

 

B-95


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Appointment of Internal Statutory Auditors

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR the appointment or reelection of statutory auditors, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the statutory reports presented or the audit procedures used;

 

   

Questions exist concerning any of the statutory auditors being appointed; or

 

   

The auditors have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company.

Discussion

The appointment of internal statutory auditors is a routine request for companies in Latin America, Italy, Spain, Portugal, Japan, Korea, and Russia. The statutory auditing board is usually composed of three to five members, including a group chairman and two alternate members, all of whom are expected to be independent. In addition to the regular duty of verifying corporate accounts, the auditor board is responsible for supervising management and ensuring compliance with the law and articles of association. The auditors must perform an audit of the accounts every three months and present to shareholders a report on the balance sheet at the AGM. For most countries, the auditors are elected annually and may seek reelection. RMG recommends supporting the appointment of statutory auditors unless there are serious concerns about the reports presented or questions about an auditor’s qualifications.

 

B-96


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Allocation of Income

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR approval of the allocation of income, unless:

 

   

The dividend payout ratio has been consistently below 30 percent without adequate explanation; or

 

   

The payout is excessive given the company’s financial position.

Discussion

Many countries require shareholders to approve the allocation of income generated during the year. These proposals usually, but not always, contain an allocation to dividends. When determining the acceptability of this proposal, RMG focuses primarily on the payout ratio. Payouts of less than 30 percent or more than 100 percent are a trigger for further analysis. The minimum level of 30 percent is based on a review of international practice. Payouts of more than 100 percent are a signal that the company is dipping into reserves to make the payment.

Further analysis of payout ratios should include the following: an examination of historical payouts to determine if there is a long-term pattern of low payouts, exceptional events that may have artificially modified earnings for the year, the condition of a company’s balance sheet, comparisons with similar companies both domestically and internationally, and the classification of the company as growth or mature.

Justifications for extreme payouts must be reviewed carefully. If the company has an adequate explanation for a certain payout, RMG supports the income allocation as proposed. However, if a company has a pattern of low payouts, fails to adequately justify the retention of capital, and is not experiencing above-average growth, RMG recommends opposing the proposal. A vote against the payout is also recommended if a company appears to be maintaining an excessive payout that may affect its long-term health.

 

B-97


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Stock (Scrip) Dividend Alternative

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR most stock (scrip) dividend proposals.

Vote AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

Discussion

Stock (scrip) dividend alternatives, whereby shareholders are offered the option of receiving their dividend payment in the form of fully paid ordinary shares, are common proposals worldwide. While dividend payments in the form of shares in lieu of cash do not immediately add to shareholder value, they allow companies to retain cash and to strengthen the position and commitment of long-term shareholders. RMG opposes stock dividend proposals that do not allow a cash option unless management shows that the cash outflow is detrimental to the company’s health and to long-term shareholder value.

 

B-98


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Amendments to Articles of Association

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote amendments to the articles of association on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to amend a company’s articles of association are usually motivated by changes in the company’s legal and regulatory environment, although evolution of general business practice can also prompt amendments to articles. Such proposals are especially common whenever stock exchange listing rules are revised, new legislation is passed, or a court case exposes the need to close loopholes.

Amendments to articles range from minor spelling changes to the adoption of an entirely new set of articles. While the majority of such requests are of a technical and administrative nature, minor changes in wording can have a significant impact on corporate governance. As such, RMG carefully scrutinizes any changes to a company’s articles.

From a company’s perspective, it is often more efficient to adopt a new set of articles than to introduce numerous amendments. However, bundling changes that treat different provisions of the articles into one voting item prevents shareholders from separating items of concern from routine changes. By leaving a shareholder with an all-or-nothing choice, bundling allows companies to include negative provisions along with positive or neutral changes.

When reviewing new or revised articles, RMG classifies each change according to its potential impact on shareholder value and then weighs the package as a whole. The presence of one strongly negative change may warrant a recommendation against the resolution. In assigning these classifications, RMG is not concerned with the nature of the article being amended, but rather focuses on whether the proposed change improves or worsens the existing provision.

The final criterion on which RMG bases its decision is whether failure to pass a resolution would cause an immediate loss of shareholder value. In such cases, RMG supports even a bundled resolution that includes negative changes.

 

B-99


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Change in Company Fiscal Term

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR resolutions to change a company’s fiscal term unless a company’s motivation for the change is to postpone its AGM.

Discussion

Companies routinely seek shareholder approval to change their fiscal year end. This is a decision best left to management. RMG opposes this resolution only if the company is changing its year end to postpone its AGM. Most countries require companies to hold their AGM within a certain period of time after the close of the fiscal year. If a company is embroiled in a controversy, it might seek approval to amend its fiscal year end at an EGM to avoid controversial issues at an AGM. RMG opposes the change in year end in these cases.

 

B-100


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Lower Disclosure Threshold for Stock Ownership

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote AGAINST resolutions to lower the stock ownership disclosure threshold below 5 percent unless specific reasons exist to implement a lower threshold.

Discussion

RMG’s recommended level for ownership disclosure is 5 percent. A level below that does not add substantially to shareholders’ interests and is often only a pretext for an antitakeover defense. A lower level also requires a greater number of shareholders to disclose their ownership, causing a greater burden to shareholders and to the company. Positions of more than 5 percent are significant, however, and this is the standard that the U.S. SEC uses.

In certain cases, shareholders may want to know of smaller positions — at a troubled company likely to be put in play, for example. RMG examines these companies to determine if these lower thresholds would benefit shareholders.

 

B-101


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Amend Quorum Requirements

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to amend quorum requirements for shareholder meetings on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Quorum requirements differ widely by market. In the United States, for instance, a quorum of a majority of the outstanding shares is the norm. In many global markets, however, the percentage of shares represented at meetings is not as high as in the United States. Indeed, many companies incorporated in markets outside the United States have difficulty attaining a quorum.

Proposals to amend the quorum requirement are evaluated on a case-by-case basis based on market norms, the company’s reasons for the change, and the company’s ownership structure. With respect to the latter, companies that have a substantial shareholder or shareholder group should set their quorum requirement well above the percentage of shares owned by such shareholder or shareholder group. Quorum requirements are intended to ensure that a broad range of shareholders are represented at meetings. Setting a quorum requirement that is too low, whether in absolute terms or relative to the holdings of a large shareholder, undermines this purpose. A low quorum requirement is of particular concern in markets where resolutions are decided on the basis of either shares present and entitled to vote at a meeting or votes cast at the meeting; in such cases, once a quorum is attained the shares present, regardless of whether they are representative of the entire body of shareholders, will be able to decide the matters under consideration at the meeting.

 

B-102


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Transact Other Business

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote AGAINST other business when it appears as a voting item.

Discussion

This item provides a forum for questions and any other resolutions that may be brought up at the meeting. In most countries the item is a formality and does not require a shareholder vote, but companies in certain countries include other business as a voting item. Because shareholders who vote by proxy cannot know what issues will be raised under this item, RMG cannot recommend that shareholders approve this request when asked for a vote. While RMG recognizes that in most cases this item is a formality or includes discussion that will have no impact on shareholders, shareholders cannot risk the negative consequences of voting in advance on an item for which information has not been disclosed.

 

B-103


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Director Elections

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR management nominees in the election of directors, unless:

 

   

Adequate disclosure has not been provided in a timely manner;

 

   

There are clear concerns over questionable finances or restatements;

 

   

There have been questionable transactions with conflicts of interest;

 

   

There are any records of abuses against minority shareholder interests; and

 

   

The board fails to meet minimum corporate governance standards.

Vote FOR individual nominees unless there are specific concerns about the individual, such as criminal wrongdoing or breach of fiduciary responsibilities.

Vote AGAINST individual directors if repeated absences at board meetings have not been explained (in countries where this information is disclosed).

Vote FOR employee and/or labor representatives if they sit on either the audit or compensation committee and are required by law to be on those committees. Vote AGAINST employee and/or labor representatives if they sit on either the audit or compensation committee, if they are not required to be on those committees.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis for contested elections of directors, e.g. the election of shareholder nominees or the dismissal of incumbent directors, determining which directors are best suited to add value for shareholders.

Please see the International Classification of Directors here.

Discussion

RMG considers director elections to be one of the most important voting decisions that shareholders make, especially because shareholders are only given the opportunity to review their companies’ operations once a year at the AGM. Thus, if detailed information on boards or nominees is available, analysis to the highest degree possible is warranted. Directors function as the representatives of shareholders throughout the year and are therefore a crucial avenue of ongoing influence on management.

Levels of disclosure regarding directors vary widely. In some countries, such as the United Kingdom, Canada, and Australia, companies publish detailed information such as director biographies, share ownership, and related information that aids shareholders in determining the level of director independence. In many other countries, the only information available on directors is their names, while still other countries disclose no information at all. In cases where detailed information about directors is not available, it would be counterproductive to vote against directors on the basis of a lack of information. Opposition to specific nominees or boards should be supported by specific problems or concerns.

RMG will recommend against the routine election of directors taking into consideration the absence of adequate or timely disclosure, questionable finances or restatements, questionable transactions with conflicts of interest, any record of abuses against minority shareholder interests, bundling of director elections, and/or any other egregious corporate governance practices.

 

B-104


Table of Contents

Boards in many countries are divided into two or more classes that are elected on a staggered basis. This system of classified boards is common across the world. Only Canadian companies routinely elect the entire board on an annual basis, but even in Canada companies may classify their board if an appropriate amendment is made to the articles. In certain countries, executive directors may be appointed for terms of up to five years, and a company’s articles may give executive directors protected board seats under which they are not subject to shareholder election. RMG opposes protected board seats and preferential treatment of executive directors.

When reviewing director election proposals, RMG examines board composition, company performance, and any negative views or information on either the company or individual directors. RMG determines the number of executive directors, independent non-executive directors, and non-independent non-executive directors on the board, the existence and composition of board committees, and the independence of the chairman. A non-independent non-executive director is defined as one who represents a major shareholder; has significant commercial contacts with the company as a legal counsel, auditor, or consultant; has held executive positions within the company in the past; or is related to the founding family, another board member, or a top executive. In cases where board composition is of concern, the company’s general health and its recent financial performance may play a part in the evaluation of directors. Individual director information is also considered, including share ownership among director nominees.

RMG also takes into account the attendance records of directors when such information is provided to shareholders, using a benchmark attendance rate of 75 percent of board meetings. If an individual director fails to attend at least 75 percent of board meetings for two or more consecutive years, RMG makes further inquiries to the company regarding the absences. RMG recommends withholding votes against the director unless the company has provided a reasonable explanation for the absences. International companies tend to have directors who reside in other countries on their boards, making attendance difficult. While RMG understands the difficulties imposed on such directors, failing to attend meetings prevents directors from fulfilling their fiduciary obligations and adequately representing shareholder interests. Other business obligations and conflicting travel schedules are not acceptable reasons for consistently poor attendance records. RMG supports the use of teleconferencing and videoconferencing to cope with the increasing time and travel demands faced by directors in global business.

Statements of corporate governance practices are also helpful in reviewing director election proposals, but only in a few countries are these routinely included as part of the annual report, usually as a listing requirement of the major stock exchange. These reports are required in Australia, Canada, South Africa, and the United Kingdom.

Voting on Director Nominees in Contested Elections

For shareholder nominees, RMG places the persuasive burden on the nominee or the proposing shareholder to prove that they are better suited to serve on the board than management’s nominees. Serious consideration of shareholder nominees will be given only if there are clear and compelling reasons for the nominee to join the board. These nominees must also demonstrate a clear ability to contribute positively to board deliberations; some nominees may have hidden or narrow agendas and may unnecessarily contribute to divisiveness among directors.

The major decision factors are:

 

   

Company performance relative to its peers

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents

 

   

Independence of directors/nominees

 

   

Experience and skills of board candidates

 

   

Governance profile of the company

 

B-105


Table of Contents

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment

 

   

Responsiveness to shareholders

 

   

Whether a takeover offer has been rebuffed

When analyzing proxy contests/ shareholder nominees, RMG focuses on two central questions: (1) Have the dissidents proved that board change is warranted? and (2) if so, are the dissident board nominees likely to effect positive change (i.e., maximize long-term shareholder value)?

 

B-106


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

International Classification of Directors

 

Executive Director

 

   

Employee or executive of the company;

 

 

   

Any director who is classified as a non-executive, but receives salary, fees, bonus, and/or other benefits that are in line with the highest-paid executives of the company.

 

Non-Independent Non-Executive Director (NED)

 

   

Any director who is attested by the board to be a non-independent NED;

 

 

   

Any director specifically designated as a representative of a significant shareholder of the company;

 

 

   

Any director who is also an employee or executive of a significant shareholder of the company;

 

 

   

Beneficial owner (direct or indirect) of at least 10 percent of the company’s stock, either in economic terms or in voting rights (this may be aggregated if voting power is distributed among more than one member of a defined group, e.g., members of a family that beneficially own less than 10 percent individually, but collectively own more than 10 percent), unless market best practice dictates a lower ownership and/or disclosure threshold (and in other special market-specific circumstances);

 

 

   

Government representative;

 

 

   

Currently provides (or a relative¹ provides) professional services² to the company, to an affiliate of the company, or to an individual officer of the company or of one of its affiliates in excess of $10,000 per year;

 

 

   

Represents customer, supplier, creditor, banker, or other entity with which company maintains transactional/commercial relationship (unless company discloses information to apply a materiality test³);

 

 

   

Any director who has conflicting or cross-directorships with executive directors or the chairman of the company;

 

 

   

Relative¹ of current employee of the company or its affiliates;

 

 

   

Relative¹ of former executive of the company or its affiliates;

 

 

   

A new appointee elected other than by a formal process through the general meeting (such as a contractual appointment by a substantial shareholder);

 

 

   

Founder/co-founder/member of founding family but not currently an employee;

 

 

   

Former executive (five-year cooling off period);

 

 

   

Years of service will NOT be a determining factor unless it is recommended best practice in a market:

 

 

   

9 years (from the date of election) in the United Kingdom and Ireland;

 

 

   

12 years in European markets;

 

 

   

7 years in Russia.

 

Independent NED

 

   

No material4 connection, either direct or indirect, to the company other than a board seat.

 

 

B-107


Table of Contents

 

Employee Representative

 

   

Represents employees or employee shareholders of the company (classified as “employee representative” but considered a non-independent NED).

Footnotes:

 

1

“Relative” follows the SEC’s proposed definition of “immediate family members” which covers spouses, parents, children, step-parents, step-children, siblings, in-laws, and any person (other than a tenant or employee) sharing the household of any director, nominee for director, executive officer, or significant shareholder of the company.

2

Professional services can be characterized as advisory in nature and generally include the following: investment banking/financial advisory services; commercial banking (beyond deposit services); investment services; insurance services; accounting/audit services; consulting services; marketing services; and legal services. The case of participation in a banking syndicate by a non-lead bank should be considered a transaction (and hence subject to the associated materiality test) rather than a professional relationship.

3

If the company makes or receives annual payments exceeding the greater of $200,000 or 5 percent of the recipient’s gross revenues. (The recipient is the party receiving the financial proceeds from the transaction.)

4

For purposes of RMG’s director independence classification, “material” will be defined as a standard of relationship (financial, personal, or otherwise) that a reasonable person might conclude could potentially influence one’s objectivity in the boardroom in a manner that would have a meaningful impact on an individual’s ability to satisfy requisite fiduciary standards on behalf of shareholders.

 

B-108


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Director Compensation

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR proposals to award cash fees to non-executive directors unless the amounts are excessive relative to other companies in the country or industry.

Vote non-executive director compensation proposals that include both cash and share-based components on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote proposals that bundle compensation for both non-executive and executive directors into a single resolution on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST proposals to introduce retirement benefits for non-executive directors.

Discussion

Proposals seeking shareholder approval for non-executive directors’ fees are not controversial in most countries. RMG generally supports resolutions regarding directors’ fees unless they are excessive relative to fees paid by other companies in the same country or industry. In evaluating such proposals, RMG focuses on the fees paid to each non-executive or, if such detailed information is not available, on the aggregate amount payable to all of the non-executives. Where available, RMG will also take into consideration evidence of past abuses, both by the company and those, if any, characteristic of the market.

Companies in many markets provide their non-executives an option to receive all or a portion of their cash fees in the form of company shares. We approve these measures as the exchange is on a “dollar-for-dollar” basis, that is, as long as a director receives shares having a cash value equal to that of the foregone fees, with the share price used for such calculation being determined on a reasonable date. While there is some dilution associated with such payments, such dilution is minimal, and in any event, increasing directors’ share ownership is likely to align the interests of the directors with those of shareholders.

However, RMG will not support such arrangements if the exchange is not dollar-for-dollar; such exchanges put shareholders at a disadvantage by providing directors the opportunity to receive shares at discount, and the interests of directors who have acquired shares at a discount are likely to be less closely aligned with those of other shareholders. Some companies provide their non-executive directors the opportunity to exchange all or a portion of their cash fees for stock options; we would evaluate such grants in accordance with our stock option guidelines.

As is already common in the United States, companies in some global markets have begun to provide their non-executives with stock options as a separate element of their remuneration. In such countries, proposals seeking approval for the remuneration of non-executive directors cannot be evaluated without detailed information regarding the proposed remuneration, which could include options, and in some cases, discounted options. Remuneration proposals that include option grants must be evaluated in accordance with the guidelines for stock options. Likewise, remuneration proposals that could include option grants — by virtue of their being proposed by a company in a market where option grants to non-employee directors are common — must also be evaluated in accordance with the guidelines for stock options.

Some countries require shareholder approval for the remuneration of executive as well as non-executive directors. Companies in such markets occasionally bundle non-executive and executive remuneration proposals into a single resolution. While RMG generally believes that executive compensation is the purview of the board,

 

B-109


Table of Contents

when proposed executive compensation is gratuitous or otherwise excessive in light of market norms or there is past evidence of abuse, RMG will recommend a vote against such resolutions. In reviewing such proposals, our analysis focuses, among other things, on the amount of the proposed compensation relative to market norms but also relative to the company’s financial performance. For example, absent performance criteria and appropriate limits, it would be inappropriate to approve a resolution entitling an executive to a bonus equal to a substantial portion of a company’s profits.

Retirement benefits for non-executive directors are inappropriate, as they increase the directors’ financial reliance on the company and could call into question the objectivity of their decision-making. In addition, most directors have served as senior executives of other companies, and adequate retirement benefits should be provided through these companies. The only caveat to this policy would be for professional non-executive directors such as those found in the United Kingdom. However, requests for such benefits in the United Kingdom are rare, and the appropriateness of using shareholder funds in this manner is questionable.

 

B-110


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Discharge of Board and Management

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

RMG will generally recommend voting for the discharge of directors, including members of the management board and/or supervisory board, unless there is reliable information about significant and compelling controversies that the board is not fulfilling its fiduciary duties warranted on a case-by-case basis by:

 

   

A lack of oversight or actions by board members which invoke shareholder distrust related to malfeasance or poor supervision, such as operating in private or company interest rather than in shareholder interest

 

   

Any legal issues (e.g. civil/criminal) aiming to hold the board responsible for breach of trust in the past or related to currently alleged action yet to be confirmed (and not only in the fiscal year in question) such as price fixing, insider trading, bribery, fraud, and other illegal actions

 

   

Other egregious governance issues where shareholders will bring legal action against the company or its directors

For markets which do not routinely request discharge resolutions (e.g. common law countries or markets where discharge is not mandatory), analysts may voice concern in other appropriate agenda items, such as approval of the annual accounts or other relevant resolutions, to enable shareholders to express discontent with the board.

Discussion

The annual formal discharge of board and management represents shareholder approval of actions taken during the year. Discharge is a tacit vote of confidence in the company’s management and policies. It does not necessarily eliminate the possibility of future shareholder action, although it does make such action more difficult to pursue. Meeting agendas normally list proposals to discharge both the board and management as one agenda item.

This is a routine item in many countries. Discharge is generally granted unless a shareholder states a specific reason for withholding discharge and plans to undertake legal action. Withholding discharge is a serious matter and is advisable only when a shareholder has concrete evidence of negligence or abuse on the part of the board or management, has plans to take legal action, or has knowledge of other shareholders’ plans to take legal action.

If evidence suggests that one or more board or management members are responsible for problems such as fraud or grave mismanagement, shareholders can withhold discharge from these individuals and pursue further legal action. Poor performance that can be directly linked to flagrant error or neglect on the part of the board or management, or board actions that are detrimental to shareholders’ interests, may also constitute grounds for voting against discharge.

If shareholders approve discharge of the board and management, they will face a greater challenge if they subsequently decide to pursue legal action against these parties. Shareholders would be required to prove that management or the board did not supply correct and complete information regarding the matter in question.

 

B-111


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Director, Officer, and Auditor Indemnification and Liability Provisions

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals seeking indemnification and liability protection for directors and officers on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST proposals to indemnify auditors.

Discussion

The scope of directors’ and officers’ indemnification and liability provisions varies by market. Within reason, RMG seeks to respect the indemnification and liability protections applicable in each market, but some markets allow companies to provide indemnification and liability protection that we deem excessive. In general, RMG believes that officers and directors should only be eligible for indemnification and liability protection if they have acted in good faith on company business and were found innocent of any civil or criminal charges for duties performed on behalf of the company. Providing indemnification and liability protection beyond such levels would effectively absolve officers and directors of their duties to shareholders. RMG recognizes that limiting a company’s ability to provide liability and indemnification protection may limit its ability to attract and retain qualified directors and executives and that indemnification provisions afford directors and officers protection to take risks and maximize shareholder wealth. However, RMG also believes that providing liability and indemnification protection in excess of that outlined above could unfairly prejudice shareholders in holding officers and directors accountable and that the level of protection allowed under our guidelines represents a reasonable compromise.

When evaluating indemnification and liability provisions in more developed markets that enumerate the duty of loyalty and the duty of care, RMG also takes into account the liability and indemnification provisions contained in RMG’s U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines.

Although RMG supports indemnifying directors and officers, RMG opposes providing these protections to auditors. These payments call into question the objectivity of the auditor in carrying out the audit, as the fees paid on its behalf could be greater than the audit fees alone. Eliminating concerns about being sued for carelessness could also lead to a decrease in the quality of the audit. Given the substantial settlements against auditors in recent years for poor audit practices, the cost of such insurance to the company and its shareholders is unwarranted.

 

B-112


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Board Structure

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR proposals to fix board size.

Vote AGAINST the introduction of classified boards and mandatory retirement ages for directors.

Vote AGAINST proposals to alter board structure or size in the context of a fight for control of the company or the board.

Discussion

Resolutions relating to board structures range from fixing the number of directors or establishing a minimum or maximum number of directors to introducing classified boards and director term limits.

Board Size

Proposals to fix board size are common and are routinely approved. Proposals to establish a range of board size are also frequent; a range of two or three open slots relative to the existing board size is reasonable, as it gives the company some flexibility to attract potentially valuable board members during the year. Latitude beyond this range is inappropriate, however, because companies can use this freedom to hinder unwanted influence from potential acquirers or large shareholders.

Adopt Classified Board

RMG prefers that all directors stand for reelection every year. All directors should be accountable to shareholders on an annual basis, as the ability to elect directors is the single most important use of the shareholder franchise.

While classified boards are the norm in most countries, some companies have chosen to place their directors up for annual election. RMG supports initiatives to declassify boards and opposes proposals to classify previously unstaggered boards. Classifying the board makes it more difficult to effect a change of control through a proxy contest; because only a minority of the directors are elected each year, a dissident shareholder would be unable to win control of the board in a single election.

Introduction of Mandatory Age of Retirement

RMG believes that age should not be the sole factor in determining a director’s value to a company. Rather, each director’s performance should be evaluated on the basis of his or her individual contribution and experience.

Altering Board Size

Companies may attempt to increase board size in order to add related or like-minded directors to the board. Conversely, establishing a minimum number of directors could make it easier to remove independent directors from the board. RMG considers these proposals on a case-by-case basis.

All proposals to alter board size during a proxy fight or other possible contests for control should be opposed. Allowing directors to alter the terms of a contest while it is underway is not in shareholders’ interests, as this tactic could be used to thwart a takeover that is in shareholders’ interests.

 

B-113


Table of Contents

Two-Tiered Boards

Companies in many countries have a two-tiered board structure, comprising a supervisory board of non-executive directors and a management board with executive directors. The supervisory board oversees the actions of the management board, while the management board is responsible for the company’s daily operations. At companies with two-tiered boards, shareholders elect members to the supervisory board only; the supervisory board appoints management board members. In Austria, Brazil, the Czech Republic, Germany, Peru, Poland, Portugal, and Russia, two-tiered boards are the norm. Company law in France and Spain also permits them.

 

B-114


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Capital Systems

Companies have one of two main types of capital systems: authorized and conditional. Both systems provide companies with the means to finance business activities, but they are considerably different in structure. Which system a company uses is determined by the economic and legal structure of the market in which it operates.

Authorized Capital System

The authorized capital system sets a limit in a company’s articles on the total number of shares that can be issued by the company’s board. The system allows companies to issue shares from this pre-approved limit, although in many markets shareholder approval must be obtained prior to an issuance. Companies also request shareholder approval for increases in authorization when the amount of shares contained in the articles is inadequate for issuance authorities. RMG reviews proposals for such increases based on the following criteria: the history of issuance requests; the size of the request; the purpose of the issuance (general or specific) associated with the increase in authorization; and the status of preemptive rights (see Share Issuance Requests).

Conditional Capital System

Under the conditional capital system, companies seek authorizations for pools of capital with fixed periods of availability. For example, if a company seeks to establish a pool of capital for general issuance purposes, it requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable piecemeal at the discretion of the board for a fixed period of time. Shares unissued after the fixed time period lapse. This type of authority would be used to carry out a general rights issue or small issuances without preemptive rights.

Requests for a specific issuance authority are tied to a specific transaction or purpose, such as an acquisition or the servicing of convertible securities. Such authorities cannot be used for any purpose other than that specified in the authorization. In this case, a company requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable as needed for the specific purpose requested. This pool of conditional capital also carries a fixed expiration date.

In reviewing these proposals, RMG takes into consideration the existence of pools of capital from previous years. Because most capital authorizations are for several years, new requests may be made on top of the existing pool of capital. While most requests contain a provision to eliminate earlier pools and replace them with the current request, this is not always the case. Thus, if existing pools of capital are being left in place, the aggregate potential dilution amount from all capital should be considered.

 

B-115


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Share Issuance Requests

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

General Issuances:

Vote FOR issuance requests with preemptive rights to a maximum of 100 percent over currently issued capital.

Vote FOR issuance requests without preemptive rights to a maximum of 20 percent of currently issued capital.

Specific Issuances:

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on all requests, with or without preemptive rights.

General Issuances

General issuance requests under both authorized and conditional capital systems allow companies to issue shares to raise funds for general financing purposes. Approval of such requests gives companies sufficient flexibility to carry out ordinary business activities without having to bear the expense of calling shareholder meetings for every issuance.

Issuances can be carried out with or without preemptive rights. Preemptive rights permit shareholders to share proportionately in any new issuances of stock. These rights guarantee existing shareholders the first opportunity to purchase shares of new issuances of stock in the class they own in an amount equal to the percentage of the class they already own. Corporate law in many countries recognizes preemptive rights and requires shareholder approval to waive such rights.

RMG believes that the ability to double share capital through a rights issue (with preemptive rights) provides the company with sufficient financing to meet most contingencies. Rights issues for general capital needs of more than 100 percent of outstanding capital warrant shareholder approval. Issuance authorities of more than 100 percent can lead to excessive cash calls on shareholders, requiring them to provide the funds necessary to maintain their relative positions in the company or to accept substantial dilution.

In some cases, companies may need the ability to raise funds for routine business contingencies without the expense of carrying out a rights issue. Such contingencies could include the servicing of option plans, small acquisitions, or payment for services. When companies make issuance requests without preemptive rights, shareholders suffer dilution as a result of such issuances. Therefore, authorizations should be limited to a fixed number of shares or a percentage of capital at the time of issuance. While conventions regarding this type of authority vary widely among countries, RMG routinely approves issuance requests without preemptive rights for up to 20 percent of a company’s outstanding capital.

Stock exchange listing rules also play a factor in determining the acceptability of share issuance requests. In some markets, companies may ask for the authority to issue all of their authorized but unissued share capital, yet the country’s stock exchange prevents a company from issuing more than ten percent of the company’s share capital in any one year without seeking additional shareholder approval. Another example is global companies that are listed on NASDAQ or the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE). Generally speaking, companies listed on NASDAQ and the NYSE must seek shareholder approval for any issuance of shares or of securities convertible into shares in excess of 20 percent of the company’s outstanding shares at the time of issuance. If stock exchange listing requirements include adequate safeguards with respect to share issuances, RMG will approve the request unless there are specific concerns with the company.

 

B-116


Table of Contents

 

Specific Issuances

Specific issuance requests should be judged on their individual merits. For example, a company may request the issuance of shares for an acquisition in the form of a rights issue to raise funds for a cash payment, or else a company could request an issuance without preemptive rights for use in a share-based acquisition or issuance to a third party. Such a request could be of any size, and RMG recommends approval as long as the proposal is sound. A more routine request would be an authority to issue shares without preemptive rights for issuance as needed upon conversion of convertible securities or to service a share option plan. These shares can only be used for the purpose defined in the resolution.

 

B-117


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Increases in Authorized Capital

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR non-specific proposals to increase authorized capital up to 100 percent over the current authorization unless the increase would leave the company with less than 30 percent of its new authorization outstanding.

Vote FOR specific proposals to increase authorized capital to any amount, unless:

 

   

The specific purpose of the increase (such as a share-based acquisition or merger) does not meet RMG guidelines for the purpose being proposed; or

 

   

The increase would leave the company with less than 30 percent of its new authorization outstanding after adjusting for all proposed issuances.

Vote AGAINST proposals to adopt unlimited capital authorizations.

Discussion

Increases in authorized capital are requested both for general financing flexibility and to provide for a specific purpose. Companies need an adequate buffer of unissued capital in order to take advantage of opportunities during the year, thus they often request increases in authorized capital for no specific purpose other than to retain this flexibility. RMG believes that approving such requests is reasonable.

An increase of 100 percent over the existing authorization gives the company sufficient flexibility in any given year, but requiring that at least 30 percent of the new authorization be outstanding also limits the company’s ability to abuse this privilege. If a company wishes to issue shares for any unforeseen reason during the year that would double (or possibly triple) outstanding share capital, an EGM to seek shareholder approval is justified.

Another important consideration is the status of preemptive rights. Not all countries recognize shareholders’ preemptive rights, and excessive authorizations could lead to substantial dilution for existing shareholders. When preemptive rights are not guaranteed, companies do not need shareholder approval for share issuances as long as the issuance does not result in an increase above the authorized capital limit.

For specific requests, increases in capital up to any size may be justified if the purpose of the new authorization is in shareholders’ interests. Such increases may be needed to fund a variety of corporate activities, thus each proposal must be reviewed on its individual merits. However, the same concerns with dilution exist if the outstanding capital is still less than 30 percent of the new authorization after all issuances take place.

RMG recommends that shareholders vote against proposals seeking to increase authorized capital to an unlimited number of shares. RMG does not believe that companies need unlimited financial flexibility to transact ordinary business because such an arrangement precludes management from periodically consulting shareholders for new capital. Unlimited authorizations may also be used as antitakeover devices, and they have the potential for substantial voting and earnings dilution; they are not in shareholders’ interests.

 

B-118


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reduction of Capital

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR proposals to reduce capital for routine accounting purposes unless the terms are unfavorable to shareholders.

Vote proposals to reduce capital in connection with corporate restructuring on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Proposals to reduce capital can cover a variety of corporate actions, ranging from routine accounting measures to reductions pertaining to a significant corporate restructuring in the face of bankruptcy. In addition, proposals to reduce capital can vary significantly from market to market as a result of local laws and accounting standards. Some examples of capital reduction proposals found overseas include:

Reduction in Stated Capital

One example of this type of proposal asks shareholders to allow the board to reduce the company’s deficit and create a contributed surplus by effecting a reduction in the state capital of the company’s common shares. A company may take this action if its net assets are in danger of falling below the aggregate of its liabilities and its stated capital. Should that situation occur, under some corporate law statutes the company would be prohibited from paying dividends on its shares. RMG usually supports such proposals as they are considered to be routine accounting measures. This type of proposal is seen often in Canada.

Reduction in Connection with Cancellation of Repurchased Shares

A company may also seek a reduction in capital corresponding to the cancellation of shares repurchased in connection with an earlier buyback authorization. The amount of equity that may be cancelled is usually limited to ten percent by national law. This type of proposal is seen most often in Scandinavia, Japan, Spain, and some Latin America markets and is considered a routine accounting measure.

Reduction in Connection with Dividend Payments

If a board determines growth in income to be insufficient to enable the payment of a dividend, it may propose to lower the par value of the company’s shares and pay the difference in par value back to the shareholders, effecting a corresponding reduction in capital. Such reduction is normally effected proportionately against all outstanding capital, and therefore does not involve any material change relative to shareholder value.

Thus, RMG generally recommends that shareholders vote for these proposals, which are most often seen in Switzerland, Spain, and some Latin American markets.

Reduction in Connection with Repayment and Cancellation of Deferred Shares and Preference Shares

Companies may also seek approval for the reduction of share capital pursuant to a repayment and cancellation of deferred shares or preference shares. Deferred shares may be created as bonus shares by a company capitalizing credit from a share premium account pursuant to a reorganization plan, for example, to return excess capital back to shareholders. The company then repurchases the bonus shares in exchange for cash equal to their nominal value and cancels them through a capital reduction. Companies that have preference shares outstanding may also request to cancel and repay these shares which may no longer be required for the carrying out of their financial objectives and may accrue administration costs which have become disproportionate to the

 

B-119


Table of Contents

benefits of maintaining such shares. Preference shares also carry certain rights that restrict the flexibility of conducting certain corporate actions, in particular share repurchases, which is another reason why companies propose to cancel such shares. In either case, RMG supports such reductions as they simplify capital structure and save on administration costs and remove certain restrictions associated with preference shares. This type of proposal is commonly seen in the United Kingdom.

Reduction in Connection with Restructuring

As noted above, some proposals to reduce capital are made in connection with a significant corporate restructuring. RMG generally supports such proposals because opposition could lead to insolvency, which is not in shareholders’ interests. Evaluation of this type of proposal should take a realistic approach to the company’s situation and the future prospects for shareholders.

 

B-120


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Capital Structures

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR resolutions that seek to maintain or convert to a one-share, one-vote capital structure.

Vote AGAINST requests for the creation or continuation of dual-class capital structures or the creation of new or additional supervoting shares.

Discussion

A key decision for any business is determining its capital structure. When timed correctly, sophisticated capital management — finding the right mixes of equity, long-term debt, and short-term financing — can enhance shareholder returns. This process involves coordination of important issues, including dividend policy, tax and interest rates, types of assets, opportunities for growth, ability to finance new projects internally, and cost of obtaining additional capital.

These decisions are best left to a company’s board and senior management, who should be given the latitude to determine the company’s capital structure. However, shareholders should be aware that many financing decisions could have an adverse effect on shareholder returns. For example, additional equity financing may reduce an existing shareholder’s ownership interest and can dilute the value of the investment. Some capital requests can be used as takeover defenses; in response to this situation, company laws establish limits on management’s authority to issue new capital and often require shareholder approval for significant changes in management’s existing authorizations.

RMG supports a one-share, one-vote policy and opposes mechanisms that skew voting rights. Shareholders’ voting rights should accrue in accordance with their equity capital commitment to the company. Dual-class capital structures entrench certain shareholders and management, insulating them from possible takeovers or other external influence or action. The interests of parties with voting control may not be the same as those of shareholders constituting a majority of the company’s capital. Additionally, research and market experience have shown that companies with dual-class capital structures or other antitakeover mechanisms consistently trade at a discount to similar companies without such structures.

When companies with dual class capital structures seek shareholder approval for the creation of new shares, RMG opposes the creation of additional supervoting shares because this perpetuates the dual class structure. If companies are seeking to increase ordinary or subordinate share capital, RMG reviews such requests on a case-by-case basis. If the shares are needed for a specific purpose, RMG recommends approval as long as the proposal meets the issuance guidelines for specific requests. Refusing such requests could cause an immediate loss of shareholder value by not allowing the company to carry out its ordinary business. However, RMG opposes general share creation requests on the grounds that they would perpetuate unequal voting structures. If shareholders routinely approve the creation of ordinary or subordinate voting shares, the company has no incentive to reform its capital structure. By not approving such requests, shareholders can send a signal of dissatisfaction to management.

If a company submits a proposal, which in effect would narrow the gap between the number of votes attached to each share class but not necessarily eliminate the inequality, RMG may still consider supporting the proposal since it entails an improvement compared to the current situation.

 

B-121


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Preferred Stock

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR the creation of a new class of preferred stock or for issuances of preferred stock up to 50 percent of issued capital unless the terms of the preferred stock would adversely affect the rights of existing shareholders.

Vote FOR the creation/issuance of convertible preferred stock as long as the maximum number of common shares that could be issued upon conversion meets RMG’s guidelines on equity issuance requests.

Vote AGAINST the creation of a new class of preference shares that would carry superior voting rights to the common shares.

Vote AGAINST the creation of blank check preferred stock unless the board clearly states that the authorization will not be used to thwart a takeover bid.

Vote proposals to increase blank check preferred authorizations on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Preferred stock is an equity security, but also has certain features that liken it to debt instruments, such as fixed dividend payments, seniority of claims relative to regular common stock, and (in most cases) no voting rights except on matters that affect the seniority of preferred stock as a class. Preferred stock usually ranks senior to a company’s ordinary shares with respect to dividends and the distribution of assets or winding up of the company. Preferred stock can be an effective means of raising capital without increasing debt levels, especially if a company has recently concluded a series of acquisitions.

In determining the acceptability of proposals relating to preferred stock, RMG examines the rights and terms of the proposed shares, including their designation, conditions, restrictions, and limitations. RMG prefers that the terms of preferred stock be set out at the time of the issuance or authorization request. Also important is the company’s justification for issuing or authorizing preferred stock. Whether or not the preferred shares carry voting rights is also considered, especially if the preferred stock will feature superior voting rights to the common shares. While RMG believes that preferred shares are a valid form of financing, we also believe that the creation or issuance of preference shares should be limited to 50 percent of a company’s share capital. RMG will also oppose cases where there has been evidence of management abuse of a past issuance authority.

Voting Preferred Stock

In some markets, preferred stock carries voting rights. Such preference shares may carry voting rights equal to the voting rights of the common shares or may carry multiple voting rights. In such cases, RMG’s guidelines on capital structure are applied. RMG supports a one share, one vote policy and opposes measures that seek to establish dual-class capital structures. However, if a company already has a preference share authorization with different voting rights than the common shares, RMG will approve additional issuances of the preference shares, as long as issuances of these preferred shares are limited and do not adversely affect the rights of common shareholders.

Convertible Preferred Stock

Companies may also seek approval for the creation or issuance of preferred stock that is convertible into common stock. If the shares are convertible into common shares, RMG evaluates the conversion ratio and

 

B-122


Table of Contents

calculates the maximum number of shares that could be issued upon conversion to determine the potential amount of dilution that could result for common shareholders as a result of the proposal. RMG’s equity issuance guidelines are then applied to determine whether the level of dilution is in shareholder’s best interests.

Blank Check Preferred Stock

Companies may also seek shareholder approval for blank check preferred stock, which refers to blanket authorities to issue preferred stock under which the directors are allowed to set the size, terms, and recipient of such shares at the time of issuance. Blank check preferred stock can be used for legitimate corporate purposes such as raising capital or making acquisitions. By not establishing the terms of preferred stock at the time the class of stock is created, companies maintain the flexibility to tailor their preferred stock offerings to prevailing market conditions. However, blank check preferred stock can also be used as an entrenchment device. The ability to issue a block of preferred stock with multiple voting or conversion rights to a friendly investor is a powerful takeover defense.

RMG supports blank check preferred stock proposals as long as the proposal states that the shares will not be issued as a takeover defense. RMG also considers, on a case-by-case basis, proposals to increase authorizations of blank check preferred stock when shareholders have already approved the class of stock and the company has a history of issuing such stock for legitimate financing purposes. Theoretically, companies with authorized blank check preferred stock can use these shares for antitakeover purposes as long as there are a few shares remaining, as they are free to set voting or conversion terms with each issue. Therefore, an increase in authorization may have little effect on the usage of this stock. In cases where a company has issued preferred stock from its authorization for legitimate financing purposes, there is no reason to object to an increase.

 

B-123


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Debt Issuance Requests

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote non-convertible debt issuance requests on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, with or without preemptive rights.

Vote FOR the creation/issuance of convertible debt instruments as long as the maximum number of common shares that could be issued upon conversion meets RMG’s guidelines on equity issuance requests.

Vote FOR proposals to restructure existing debt arrangements unless the terms of the restructuring would adversely affect the rights of shareholders.

Discussion

Debt issuance is a popular financing strategy in world markets. Companies routinely issue bonds directly to shareholders in order to raise funds while enjoying low borrowing costs, although bonds are also often issued without preemptive rights. The issuance of unsecured debt can often include warrants, which are detached at the time of bond issuance. Warrants are usually attached to a debt issuance in order to enhance the marketability of the accompanying fixed income security. Debt instruments are often issued with the right to convert into equity securities. Convertible bonds give holders the choice of becoming shareholders, thereby increasing the shareholder base and liquidity of the company’s stock, or selling their newly converted shares on the open market. In addition, many companies issue debt denominated in currencies other than that of their home market.

When evaluating a debt issuance request, RMG determines the type of debt instrument being issued, the characteristics of the instrument (including whether or not it is convertible into common stock), the intended recipient of the issuance, and the company’s justification for the issuance.

In the case of convertible debt, RMG evaluates the conversion ratio and calculates the maximum number of shares that could be issued upon conversion to determine the potential amount of dilution that could result from the proposal. RMG’s equity issuance guidelines are then applied to determine whether the level of dilution is in shareholders’ best interests.

In the case of non-convertible debt, RMG takes into account the size and purpose of the increase, and the board’s use of past authorizations including examining whether there has been a history of abuse of the authorities. RMG looks at the company’s current financial situation, specifically examining its current debt-to-equity ratio, or gearing level. A high gearing level may incline markets and financial analysts to downgrade the company’s bond rating, increasing its investment risk factor in the process. RMG also considers other factors such as the company’s growth over the past five years relative to earnings or market capitalization, recent corporate events that might affect the company’s bottom line (such as the acquisition of a major competitor or the release of a revolutionary product), and the normal debt levels in the company’s industry and country of origin. Although all of these considerations are factored into RMG’s analysis of debt issuance proposals, RMG generally believes that such financing concerns are best decided by management. RMG will, however, issue vote recommendations against such proposals in cases where there has been evidence of management abuse of an authority, where the proposal is not in line with market practices, or extreme cases where shareholders’ rights could be negatively affected.

Companies may also seek shareholder approval to restructure existing debt arrangements. RMG generally supports restructuring proposals, particularly if the company is in danger of default. However, RMG will oppose restructuring proposals in which common shareholders are being treated unfairly.

 

B-124


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Pledging of Assets for Debt

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to approve the pledging of assets for debt on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

In certain countries, shareholder approval is required when a company needs to secure a debt issuance with its assets. In many cases, this is a routine request and is a formality under the relevant law. When reviewing such proposals, RMG takes into account the terms of the proposed debt issuance and the company’s overall debt level. If both of these factors are acceptable, RMG recommends supporting these requests.

 

B-125


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Increase in Borrowing Powers

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to approve increases in a company’s borrowing powers on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

In some countries, companies are required to seek shareholder approval for increases in their aggregate borrowing power authorities. The aggregate limit on the board’s ability to borrow money is often fixed in a company’s articles, and shareholder approval to change this limit is therefore legally required. RMG believes that a company’s financing needs are best determined by the board, and modest increases in borrowing powers are necessary to allow the company to take advantage of new acquisition opportunities or to complete development and restructuring projects. RMG’s analysis of borrowing power increase requests takes into account management’s stated need for the increase, the size of the increase, and the company’s current gearing level. Large increases in borrowing powers can sometimes result in dangerously high debt-to-equity ratios that could harm shareholder value. If an increase is excessive without sufficient justification and if a company already has exceptionally high gearing compared to its industry, RMG recommends opposing the request.

 

B-126


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Share Repurchase Plans

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Generally vote FOR share repurchase programs/market repurchase authorities, provided that the proposal meets the following parameters:

 

   

Maximum volume: 10 percent for market repurchase within any single authority and 10 percent of outstanding shares to be kept in treasury (“on the shelf”)

 

   

Duration does not exceed 18 months.

RMG will recommend AGAINST any proposal where:

 

   

The repurchase can be used for takeover defense;

 

   

There is clear evidence of abuse;

 

   

There is no safeguard against selective buybacks;

 

   

Pricing provisions and safeguards are deemed to be unreasonable in light of market practice

RMG may support share repurchase plans in excess of 10 percent volume under exceptional circumstances, such as one-off company specific events (e.g. capital restructuring). Such proposals will be assessed CASE-BY-CASE based on merits, which should be clearly disclosed in the annual report, provided that following conditions are met:

 

   

The overall balance of the proposed plan seems to be clearly in shareholders’ interests;

 

   

The plan still respects the 10 percent maximum of shares to be kept in treasury.

Discussion

Proposals regarding share repurchase plans are routine in most countries, and such plans are usually sufficiently regulated by local laws or listing requirements to protect shareholder interests.

RMG looks for the following conditions in share repurchase plans: limitations on a company’s ability to use the plan to repurchase shares from third parties at a premium; limitations on the exercise of the authority to thwart takeover threats; and a requirement that repurchases be made at arm’s length through independent third parties and that selective repurchases require shareholder approval.

Share repurchase programs often involve positive financial consequences to shareholders, as they generally increase the level of earnings per share and bring greater liquidity to the share. Therefore we are generally supportive of share buybacks.

For markets that either generally do not specify the maximum duration of the authority or seek a duration beyond 18 months that is allowable under market specific legislation, RMG will assess the company’s historic practice. If there is evidence that a company has sought shareholder approval for the authority to repurchase shares on an annual basis, RMG will support the proposed authority. In Greece, the legal framework allows share repurchase authorizations to last a maximum of 24 months, although they are typically renewed on a yearly basis. Greek companies typically request shareholders to approve share repurchase schemes in line with provisions in the Company Act. Rarely does a company specify the exact duration of the authorization. Therefore, it is assumed that the duration could be up to 24 months, as foreseen in the legal framework. Around half of Austrian companies restrict share repurchase plans to a limit of 18 months, the majority of Austrian companies either ask for a maximum of 30 months or do not disclose the duration at all.

 

B-127


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reissuance of Shares Repurchased

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR requests to reissue any repurchased shares unless there is clear evidence of abuse of this authority in the past.

Discussion

RMG generally believes that properly timed repurchases of company shares can enhance shareholder value and improve general shareholder returns. With good timing and proper safeguards, the same returns and improvements in shareholder value can be generated through the reissuance of the shares repurchased. In most countries, the text of this general mandate provides sufficient shareholder protection to make this item routine. When reviewing such proposals, RMG takes into account the country’s legal framework for such reissuances and the company’s history of reissuing shares under the authority.

 

B-128


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Capitalization of Reserves for Bonus Issues/Increase In Par Value

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR requests to capitalize reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase par value.

Discussion

Companies routinely carry out bonus issues of shares or increases in par value to existing shareholders, usually through the capitalization of reserves from either the share premium reserve or the retained earnings account. Capitalization of these reserves — transferring them into the share capital account — usually requires shareholder approval. These issuances essentially function as dividends.

When companies increase par value or capitalize reserves and distribute new fully paid shares to shareholders free of charge through a bonus issue, there is no cost to shareholders to maintain their stakes and no risk of dilution. This procedure transfers wealth to shareholders and does not significantly impact share value. The only impact on shareholders is that by increasing the number of shares on issue, the company could increase liquidity, enhance marketability, and ultimately expand its shareholder base.

 

B-129


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reorganizations/Restructurings

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote reorganizations and restructurings on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to approve corporate reorganizations or restructurings range from the routine shuffling of subsidiaries within a group to major rescue programs for ailing companies. RMG usually approves such resolutions unless there are clear conflicts of interest among the various parties, shareholders’ rights are being negatively affected, or certain groups or shareholders appear to be getting a better deal at the expense of general shareholders.

In the case of routine reorganizations of assets or subsidiaries within a group, RMG’s primary focus with the proposed changes is to ensure that shareholder value is being preserved. This includes the effect of the reorganization on the control of group assets, the final ownership structure, the relative voting power of existing shareholders if the share capital is being adjusted, and the expected benefits arising from the changes.

In the case of a distress restructuring of a company or group, shareholders’ options are far more limited; often, they have no choice but to approve the restructuring or lose everything. In such cases, RMG first determines the company’s degree of distress by determining whether or not the company still has a positive net asset value — that is, if realizable assets are greater than liabilities. Although rare, liquidation should be considered an option in these situations.

In most cases, however, the company has a negative asset value, meaning that shareholders would have nothing left after a liquidation. RMG seeks to ensure that the degree of dilution proposed is consistent with the claims of outside parties and is commensurate with the relative commitments of other company stakeholders. Existing shareholders usually must accept the transfer of majority control over the company to outside secured creditors. Ultimately, ownership of a small percentage of something is worth more than majority ownership of nothing.

 

B-130


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Mergers and Acquisitions

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on mergers and acquisitions taking into account the following:

For every M&A analysis, RMG reviews publicly available information as of the date of the report and evaluates the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors including:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, RMG places emphasis on the offer premium, market reaction, and strategic rationale.

 

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction will cause RMG to scrutinize a deal more closely.

 

 

   

Strategic rationale — Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions.

 

 

   

Conflicts of interest — Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? RMG will consider whether any special interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger.

 

 

   

Governance — Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance.

 

Vote AGAINST if the companies do not provide sufficient information upon request to make an informed voting decision.

Discussion

When evaluating the merits of a proposed acquisition, merger, or takeover offer, RMG focuses on the impact of the proposal on shareholder value, both in the immediate and long term. The primary concern is to determine whether or not the proposal is beneficial to shareholders’ existing and future earnings stream and to ensure that the impact on voting rights is not disproportionate to that benefit. Although RMG examines these proposals closely from a corporate governance perspective, a variety of other factors are considered, including the financial terms of the transaction and the strategic rationale for the proposal.

In the case of an acquisition, RMG examines the level of voting or earnings dilution and the logic of the proposed purchase if large share issuances are required. The method of financing is also important, as various methods can result in different valuations than originally perceived. RMG also checks for an independent valuation of the terms, particularly if the target of the acquisition is not a publicly traded entity or asset and precise market valuations are not readily available. RMG also considers the control premium in the transaction. Control premiums on acquisitions vary widely depending on the industry, the time period, and the country. For publicly traded entities or assets, RMG looks at the price of the acquisition relative to the average market price prior to any announcement, as well as the historical price trends for 60 days prior. For non-publicly traded entities or assets, an independent financial evaluation becomes even more important.

 

B-131


Table of Contents

In the case of mergers, RMG examines whether or not the merger makes commercial or strategic sense for the company. RMG also considers the method of effecting the merger and the ultimate impact on shareholders of the proposed financial and corporate governance structure. While historical relative valuations based on market prices are useful in the financial evaluation process, the often-complicated financial details of such proposals make an independent fairness opinion of extreme importance. The proposed board structure, share capital structure, relative share ownership, and any takeover defenses of the new company are all important factors for consideration in this evaluation process.

Obviously, levels of disclosure regarding merger and acquisition proposals will vary greatly from market to market. In more developed markets, shareholders are often provided with detailed financial and governance information as well as an independent fairness opinion and in some cases, a formal valuation report. When evaluating proposals in these markets, RMG relies primarily on the documents and information provided by the company and its advisors. However, in many emerging markets, detailed information regarding mergers and acquisitions can be scarce. In these markets, RMG must rely more heavily on secondary sources, including local shareholder associations, market reaction to the proposed transaction, and news reports.

If the details of a given proposal are unclear or not available and a fairness opinion (in markets where they are regularly provided) is also not available, RMG recommends voting against the proposal. If a company is uncooperative in providing information about the proposal or is evasive when responding to questions, RMG recommends voting against the item in question.

 

B-132


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Mandatory Takeover Bid Waivers

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to waive mandatory takeover bid requirements on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Many countries impose a bid threshold that forces any shareholder whose stake exceeds the limit to tender a public bid to all the other owners to purchase the remaining shares. The thresholds are imposed either by national law, stock exchange rules, or a company’s articles of association. This mandatory takeover bid rule prohibits a shareholder from owning a large stake in the company and having a dominating voice in the decision-making without being required to purchase the remainder of the shares. Without such a requirement, the other shareholders, although potentially holding a substantial percentage of the company’s shares, would be left with relatively little say in decisions. Mandatory bid requirements also seek to prevent “creeping acquisitions” and to ensure that shareholders, other than the controlling shareholder, receive a control premium when control of the company shifts to the large shareholder.

RMG opposes proposals to exempt a large shareholder from the obligation to bid. The requirement that a takeover bid should be launched when a substantial amount of shares have been acquired prevents the entrenchment of the controlling shareholder and protects minority owners.

RMG does make an exception to the mandatory takeover bid rule when the event prompting the takeover bid is a repurchase by the company of its own shares. When a company repurchases its own shares, the relative stake of a large shareholder increases even though the number of shares held by the large shareholder has not changed. In certain markets, notably the United Kingdom and Ireland, the mandatory bid rules require a large shareholder to make a takeover bid if its stake in the company is increased on a relative basis as a result of a share repurchase by the company. Companies in these markets may seek a waiver from the takeover bid requirement applicable to their large shareholder. Under certain circumstances, RMG will support such a waiver, namely, if the share repurchase would not push the large shareholder’s stake in the company above 50 percent.

 

B-133


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reincorporation Proposals

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote reincorporation proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Reincorporation proposals are most commonly seen in Canada, where companies may register under one of the provincial business statutes. However, companies in other countries may also seek shareholder approval to reincorporate in a U.S. state or another country. Many companies, including U.S. companies, choose to reincorporate in places such as Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, or the British Virgin Islands for tax purposes.

When examining a reincorporation proposal, RMG first examines the reasons for the move. Sometimes a reincorporation proposal is part of a restructuring effort or merger agreement that contributes significantly to a company’s growth, financial health, and competitive position more than the anticipated negative consequences of incorporating in another province or country. Some reincorporations allow firms to realize lower taxes or incorporation fees. In addition, there may be advantages to incorporating in the province in which the company conducts the bulk of its business.

Companies often adopt a new charter or bylaws with increased protection for management upon reincorporation. For instance, many reincorporation proposals are bundled with the ratification of a new charter that increases the company’s capital stock or imposes a classified board. When such changes to the charter include the addition of negative corporate governance provisions, the impact of these new provisions on shareholders must be balanced against the anticipated benefits of the reincorporation.

RMG believes that reincorporations to countries, states, or provinces with less stringent disclosure requirements or corporate governance provisions are often management attempts to lessen accountability to shareholders. In such cases, RMG recommends voting against the proposal. The expenses involved in a change of domicile relating to legal and administrative fees, plus the greater entrenchment such a reincorporation could provide management, would likely harm shareholders’ interests. In cases where companies propose to move to a more protective province or country and supply reasonable financial reasons for doing so, the benefits of the reincorporation must be weighed against the costs of possible management entrenchment.

 

B-134


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Expansion of Business Activities

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR resolutions to expand business activities unless the new business takes the company into risky areas.

Discussion

Companies are usually required by law to include in their articles of association or memorandum of association specific business purposes in the form of an objects clause. Because most countries require shareholder approval before articles can be amended, any change to the company’s objects clause requires shareholder approval. Countries often seek shareholder approval to amend the objects clause to expand business lines.

Expanding business lines is a decision usually best left to management, but there are some instances where RMG withholds support for such changes. If a company has performed poorly for several years and seeks business expansion into a risky enterprise, RMG would require further clarification from management regarding the purpose of the expansion. If the company does not provide a satisfactory business plan, RMG recommends that shareholders vote against the proposal.

 

B-135


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Related-Party Transactions

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote related-party transactions on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Shareholders are often asked to approve commercial transactions between related parties. A transaction between a parent company and its subsidiary, or a company’s dealings with entities that employ the company’s directors, are usually classified as related-party transactions and are subject to company law or stock exchange listing requirements that mandate shareholder approval. Shareholder approval of these transactions is meant to protect shareholders against insider trading abuses.

In most cases, both the rationale and terms of such transactions are reasonable. RMG looks for evidence of an evaluation of the transaction by an independent body, but this is not always available. Unless the agreement requests a strategic move outside the company’s charter or contains unfavorable terms, RMG recommends that shareholders support the proposal.

 

B-136


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Compensation Plans

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote compensation plans on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Disclosure on compensation in many markets is still not as extensive as U.S.-style disclosure. However, compensation plans are becoming more common on meeting agendas of non-U.S. companies, and the structures of these plans are of vital interest to shareholders. When given the opportunity to review these structures, RMG supports plans that motivate participants to focus on long-term shareholder value and returns, encourage employee stock ownership, and more closely align employee interests with those of shareholders.

For many years, RMG has employed a complex compensation model methodology for evaluating compensation proposals in the United States and Canada, but this has only been possible because of the extensive disclosure provided in these markets’ proxy circulars. This degree of disclosure is a reflection of strict regulatory requirements, investor concern and activity, and corporate governance sophistication.

Beyond the problems presented by limited disclosure, local conditions and traditions in particular countries also hinder the creation of a comprehensive compensation evaluation procedure. Standard market practice in one country may be illegal activity in another. Some countries establish numerical limits on the number of shares available under their plans, while others have percentage limits that apply over a specific length of time. Holding all global companies to the strict standards of the United States, for example, could result in recommendations against almost every compensation plan in many countries. Conversely, making too many allowances for local practices may only encourage poor governance standards over the long term.

RMG reviews three main types of compensation plans: stock option plans, incentive plans, and share purchase plans. Also included in this section are grants outside of plans. RMG analyzes plans by calculating the potential dilution under a company’s share plans and by analyzing plan features.

Stock Option Plans

Stock option plans grant participants an option to buy company shares at a set price (the exercise price). Shares are usually granted at market prices and may be exercised when the company’s share price reaches the exercise price. Participants may then purchase the promised shares at the strike price and may later sell the shares after their purchase (or after a defined holding period when the shares may not be sold).

When evaluating stock option plans, RMG’s first hurdle is obtaining information regarding the key terms of the plan. Ideally, we would like to see the full text of the plan, or a summary of the plan’s key terms, with information on the plan’s dilution, exercise price/presence of discounts, administration and participation, types of awards used, vesting provisions, and performance criteria. However, in many markets, especially where companies are only beginning to introduce stock-based compensation, information on key plan terms can be quite limited. RMG generally supports efforts to more closely align executive pay with shareholder interests, and generally encourages companies to improve their compensation disclosure practices. However, until disclosure standards improve in these markets, RMG believes that it would be counterproductive to oppose all plans in a given country on this basis. Still, some basic parameters are necessary in order for RMG to consider supporting a compensation plan. At a minimum, RMG requires information on the maximum potential dilution of a plan and information concerning the exercise price. If a plan meets our guidelines on these two points, RMG will support the plan. For markets where certain plan information is regularly disclosed, and a company has failed to provide this information to shareholders, RMG will vote against the plan on the basis of substandard disclosure.

 

B-137


Table of Contents

 

Among the criteria that RMG examines in evaluating stock option plans are the following, generally organized from criteria of greater importance to criteria of lesser importance:

Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options Under the Plan

The maximum number of shares RMG approves under a plan depends on the classification of a company’s stage of development as growth or mature. Growth companies are usually smaller, in new industries requiring significant research and development, and have restricted cash flows. A company in an established industry but expanding rapidly, or a mature company that is experiencing an extended period of rapid expansion, may also be classified as growth. Mature companies are characterized by stable sales and revenue growth, production efficiencies resulting from volume gains, and strong cash flow resulting from developed products in the payoff stage.

For mature companies, shares available under stock option plans should be no more than 5 percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans. For growth companies, shares available should be no more than 10 percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans. However, RMG will support plans at mature companies with dilution levels of up to 10 percent if the plan includes other positive features, such as challenging performance criteria or premium-priced options. These features partially offset dilution concerns, as their inclusion reduces the likelihood that options will become exercisable unless there is a clear improvement in shareholder value.

For all companies, an absolute number of shares fixed at the time of approval is ideal, but many countries do not include such a limit. In these cases, revolving limits (a certain percentage of issued shares at any one time) of 5 percent or 10 percent are common. The practice of setting a percentage of shares issuable over a certain number of years before or after the plan is adopted appears to be a compromise between these first two methods. RMG prefers plans where the limits are sufficiently spread out, e.g., 5 percent in five years, 10 percent in ten years. Revolving limits of 10 percent in ten years should also include “flow-rate” restrictions that further limit the plan’s dilution, such as a cap of “3 percent in three years,” “2.5 percent in five years,” or “1 percent in one year.”

Exercise Price

RMG prefers that options be priced at not less than 100 percent of the shares’ fair market value on the date of grant. Usually this is taken as the closing price of the company’s shares on the day prior to the date of grant. Some countries determine fair market value as an average of the trading price for the five days prior to the date of grant. This is a common and acceptable practice. Some emerging market countries use a 30-day average or longer to determine fair market value; these resolutions must be reviewed on a case-by-case basis, although provisions of longer than 30 days increase the possibility of discounted options.

Discounted Options, Restricted Stock, and Stock Grants

Many countries allow for options to be granted at a discount to market prices. RMG evaluates restricted stock, which is essentially a deeply discounted option often with mandatory vesting provisions, in the same manner as a discounted option. Restricted stock, which is generally offered at a 100-percent discount and vests in three to five years, is most often seen in the United States, but it is becoming increasingly popular in other jurisdictions. Stock grants are another type of discounted award in which company shares may be granted outright to recipients with no payment required for the receipt of shares. In the absence of performance criteria (see below), RMG opposes grants of discounted options, including restricted stock. Absent performance criteria or vesting provisions, holders of discounted options or restricted stock have an incentive to cash in their grants for an immediate return rather than hold on to their options for future gains, thereby reducing or eliminating the incentive value of such awards. RMG generally opposes stock grants as their incentive value is dubious.

 

B-138


Table of Contents

 

In very rare cases, RMG may consider supporting a plan that includes discounted options, including restricted stock, if the company has attached challenging performance criteria to the options, including price hurdles. Performance-based vesting provisions require tangible improvements in the company’s financial performance or share price before the discounted options or restricted shares can be exercised. Performance criteria are evaluated by reference to both the company’s country of incorporation and industry. Recipients of discounted options and restricted shares are required to tender less consideration, if any, to exercise their awards than recipients of market-priced options are required to tender; as a result, the former type of awards are more costly to shareholders from an economic perspective. However, the higher performance threshold imposed by suitably challenging performance criteria may mitigate the higher economic costs.

In general, RMG does not believe that vesting provisions, however stringent, sufficiently mitigate the excessive cost of discounted awards, but with respect to the use of restricted stock in U.S.-style stock option plans seen in global markets, RMG recognizes that restricted stock is a common feature of these plans, that often these awards represent only a small portion (usually significantly below 1 percent) of a company’s outstanding share capital, and that performance criteria are not common in U.S.-style plans. As a result, RMG believes that it would be counterproductive to oppose all such plans solely on the inclusion of restricted stock. However, RMG would only approve of plans that set out strict limits on such grants, include stringent vesting provisions, sufficiently challenging performance criteria, and that meet our guidelines in all other aspects.

Plan Administration

RMG opposes allowing the administering committee to grant options to itself due to the potential for abuse and conflicts of interest. Administration of plans should be in the hands of directors who are unable to participate in the plan. Plans administered by the full board should not allow voting by executive directors; plans administered by remuneration committees should be composed entirely of independent directors. Plans that allow non-executive directors to participate should not give them any discretion on individual grants; instead, an automatic system of grants should be introduced with fixed annual grants at market prices on a fixed date. Alternatively, RMG approves of separate non-executive director option plans with independent administration if the number of shares reserved for such plans is limited. Shares reserved for director plans, when combined with shares reserved for all of the company’s stock option plans should not exceed RMG’s aggregate dilution limits. In addition, shares reserved over the life of such a plan should not exceed 1 percent of a company’s outstanding share capital for mature companies and 1.6 percent for growth-oriented companies for a five-year plan. Shares reserved for non-executive director option grants in any one year should not exceed 0.2 percent for mature companies and 0.3 percent for growth companies.

Eligibility and Participation

RMG prefers separate plans for employees, directors, and non-executive directors, but most plans include all or some combination of these categories of participants. Other global plans distinguish between full-time and part-time employees or establish a set length of service to the company (usually one year) before options may be granted. Most plans allow the administrating committee to select plan participants.

Performance Criteria and Vesting Provisions

Performance criteria and vesting provisions are important considerations when evaluating a compensation plan, and the existence of long vesting provisions and realistic performance criteria may compensate for minor shortcomings in a plan. If a plan falls just beyond one of the above guidelines but has both performance criteria and vesting provisions, support may be justified. RMG prefers a minimum three-year vesting period. The ultimate goal of share option plans is to tie executive and employee remuneration to company performance and to give key employees and executives incentive to stay with the firm. We favor the inclusion of performance targets and graduated vesting schedules because awards that are contingent upon sustained and measurable improvements are more likely to fulfill their purpose of truly providing incentive. However, if a plan meets all

 

B-139


Table of Contents

other aspects of RMG’s guidelines, these two criteria are not mandatory, unless the inclusion of such provisions are standard in the company’s country of incorporation and a company has failed to include them.

Other Features Specific to Option Plans

Issue Terms

Some countries require optionees to pay a nominal fee (often equivalent to $0.01) for every option received. This is common and acceptable, although many companies that once enforced this provision are now deleting it from the rules of their plans.

Option Repricing

Some plans include specific provisions allowing for the repricing of options at the board’s discretion. RMG opposes plans that include option repricing when the exercise price is reduced in response to a dropping share price. Repricing outstanding options reduces the incentive that options provide to raise the share price for shareholders.

Financial Assistance

Some plans offer participants loans to pay the full exercise price on their options. If loans are part of a company’s option plan, RMG prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. RMG also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessary warrant a recommendation against an option plan, but they are taken into consideration in RMG’s analysis of the plan.

Plans for International Employees

Many overseas companies introduce separate plans or delegate a special section of their option plan to deal with tax considerations raised by having a large number of employees working in other countries. Many of these plans contain provisions that deal directly with particular U.S. tax code provisions on stock options. RMG applies the same criteria to these plans as to country-specific plans.

Stock Appreciation Rights

Stock appreciation rights (SARs) allow participants to receive the difference between the exercise price and the market price at the date of exercise. Many companies use SARs in lieu of regular options. While SARs do not result in the dilution associated with large option exercises, there is little difference between a SAR and a regular option from a shareholder perspective because the financial cost to the company is the same. However, SARs do not encourage stock ownership by participants because they involve no purchase or sale of company stock. RMG reviews SARs in the context of the option plan under which they are issued.

Phantom Stock Option Plans

Phantom stock options offer participants cash bonuses based on the increase in share price during a set period of time. Phantom plans are distinct from SARs in that they often form their own separate plan. Some companies will create a phantom stock option plan to award employees who reside in countries that do not allow stock-based compensation. Participants are designated a set number of hypothetical (phantom) shares, on which the award is based. While RMG prefers compensation plans that encourage employee ownership, SARs and phantom options are an effective way to provide incentive.

 

B-140


Table of Contents

 

Superoptions

Superoptions exceed the limits in a particular country for the value of options granted to any one individual, although they are usually tied to significantly more restrictive vesting provisions and performance criteria. U.K. superoptions, for example, exceed the Association of British Insurers’ recommended limit that options represent no more than one times a participant’s salary in any year, yet the stricter performance criteria and longer vesting periods usually mitigate excessive grants. Additionally, dilution resulting from superoptions has historically been fairly moderate. Superoptions appear most often in advanced markets with developed stock option plans.

Dividends Under Option and Dividend Equivalent Payment Provisions

Most holders of stock options do not receive dividend payments. However, some option plans allow participants to receive dividends or dividend equivalent payments prior to the exercise of options. RMG believes that any economic benefit derived from option plans should occur at the time of exercise.

Using Repurchased Shares in Share Compensation Plans

In many countries, companies purchase shares on the market for use in their compensation plans. In some cases, using repurchased shares is more efficient than issuing new shares to participants on exercise. RMG also recognizes the benefits to existing shareholders when repurchased shares are used to fund option grants, as dilution to their interests is minimized. However, although there is no cost to shareholders in terms of dilution of their voting interests (“voting dilution”), buybacks still represent a real cost to the company and shareholders (“economic dilution”). As a result, if a company wants to use repurchased shares in its compensation plans, RMG will include repurchased shares in its dilution calculation and apply the same dilution thresholds as for newly issued shares (see above under “Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options under the Plan”) .

RMG recommends that shareholders support a plan if it includes a specified limit on the total number of shares that could be used and if repurchased shares would count toward that limit, as long as it meets all other guidelines. However, RMG looks for an additional limitation, either an aggregate numerical limit, a percentage limit, or limitations on individual awards, when repurchased shares do not count toward the plan’s limit on newly issued shares, but rather operate as an additional pool of shares.

Incentive Plans

Share incentive plans tie key employees’ compensation more directly to company performance. Though most popular in the United Kingdom, incentive plans are becoming increasingly popular across the globe. Incentive plans provide participants with free grants of company shares (or, less frequently, cash grants) in proportion with prearranged performance criteria-often earnings per share measured against inflation or total shareholder return. These indicators are frequently compared with those of other firms in the company’s industry or stock market index, creating a benchmark and a further determinant of the number of shares granted to a particular participant. Proponents of incentive plans note that they offer shareholders the potential for less dilution and that they more directly encourage participants to focus on long-term company performance through strict performance criteria tied to more than just share price movements.

Most incentive plans are organized with strict vesting provisions, where participants may not receive the share awards until after a period of three years or more. Many plans also grant a percentage of the total amount reserved for each participant on a sliding scale measured against performance criteria. Performance criteria targets that have been satisfied only to a certain point may represent disbursement of 25 percent of the shares or cash to a participant, while 100-percent satisfaction may represent the full allotment of the grant. From a shareholder perspective, this graduated system of performance criteria is a major advance.

Evaluation of incentive plans is similar to that of option plans in that acceptable dilution and impartial administration and eligibility remain key factors for a positive recommendation. Insufficient performance criteria or abbreviated vesting provisions are deciding factors as well.

 

B-141


Table of Contents

 

Employee Stock Purchase Plans and Savings-Related Share Option Schemes

Employee stock purchase plans and savings-related share option schemes (together, ESPPs) provide employees an opportunity to purchase stock in their company, often at a discount to market prices. Plans may operate via monthly deductions from employees’ paychecks, gathered and held for safekeeping by a trust or bank, and used to purchase company stock on behalf of the employee. ESPPs can lead to greater commitment from employees, provide performance incentives, and provide all employees the opportunity to share in the company’s growth.

ESPPs differ from stock option plans in that in an ESPP, all eligible participants have the option to participate in the plan and may choose how much they wish to contribute to the plan, whereas in a stock option plan, the administering committee chooses who actually participates in the plan, that is, receives options under the plan. RMG recommends approval for many of these plans because they encourage wide share ownership in the company among employees. When analyzing ESPPs for global companies, RMG considers the following factors:

Eligibility

This is an important factor when considering ESPPs proposed by global companies. For a plan to qualify as an ESPP, all full-time employees who have been with the company for a reasonable amount of time (some plans also allow for participation by part-time employees) must be eligible to participate in the plan, and more important, eligible participants must have the ability to determine whether they will participate and to what extent they will participate, subject to certain limits, as discussed below.

Dilution

Many markets, such as the United States, Canada, Ireland, and certain tax haven markets, differentiate between shares reserved for ESPPs and shares reserved for stock option plans. In these markets it is our practice to have separate dilution limits (a) for shares reserved for ESPPs, and (b) shares reserved for stock option plans. Other markets, notably the United Kingdom, do not reserve separate pools of shares for ESPPs and option plans, therefore we cannot make such distinctions.

For those markets that reserve a separate pool of shares for ESPPs, RMG policy is to exclude such shares from our dilution calculations for stock option plans. However, RMG policy provides that no more than 10 percent of a company’s shares may be reserved for ESPPs at any given time, with such 10 percent being over and above the company’s limit (either 5 or 10 percent) reserved for option plans, as long as discounts do not exceed 15 percent. Accordingly, a company could have up to 10 percent of its shares reserved for option plans and 10 percent of its shares reserved for ESPPs at any given time. If market practice dictates a larger discount under the ESPPs, the allowable dilution will be adjusted downward proportionately. For example, if a company is allowed to offer discounts of 30 percent, the allowable dilution will be 5 percent. Allowable dilution on discounts between 15 percent and 30 percent will be determined on a pro rata basis. Alternatively, RMG would consider a higher dilution limit for ESPPs if the company in question sufficiently limited dilution under its option plans.

For those markets that reserve a common pool of shares for ESPPs and stock option plans, RMG policy is to evaluate the dilution under the common pool of shares in accordance with the dilution limitations applicable to stock option plans.

Offering Period and Offering Price

The offering period, also known as the purchase period, is the time period over which a participant’s contributions are accumulated for the purchase of shares under the plan. The offering price is the company’s share price taken on a specific date, less the applicable discount, at which a participant’s accumulated payroll deductions are used to purchase shares. Both the offering period and the offering price are country- and

 

B-142


Table of Contents

plan-specific. For example, ESPPs that are intended to comply with Section 423 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code (Section 423 Plans) and therefore qualify for favorable tax treatment may not have an offering period in excess of 27 months. Section 423 Plans, however, almost always provide for an “either/or” offering price, which provides participants the right to purchase shares at the lesser of the fair market value of that company’s shares, less the applicable discount, as of either the first or last day of the offering period. In contrast, plans in the United Kingdom and Ireland generally have a three-, five-, or even seven-year offering period, and the offering price is the fair market value on the date an employee commences participation in the plan.

RMG’s assessment of a plan takes into account the length of the offering period and the date on which the offering price is determined. If the plan has an “either/or” feature, a shorter offering period is in the interests of shareholders because such provisions reduce the market risk associated with the plan. The maximum offering period for plans with such a feature is 27 months. In contrast, if the offering price is based on the price of the company’s shares on the date plan participation commences, then a longer offering period is generally in the interests of shareholders, as it should more effectively focus the efforts of plan participants on increasing shareholder value. In these cases, the minimum offering period is three years.

Discounts

These are generally country-specific, e.g. the maximum discount under a Section 423 Plan is 15 percent. In the United Kingdom the maximum discount is 20 percent, and in Ireland it is 25 percent. The amount of the discount is often obscured because some plans do not provide for a discount per se, but rather provide that participants will receive matching shares. This practice is common in Canada. For instance, a plan may stipulate that for every two shares a participant purchases under a plan, the company will provide one “matching share” to the participant; in effect the participant receives three shares for the price of two, which is mathematically equivalent to a 33-percent discount. If a plan employs matching shares, the analyst must simply calculate the imputed discount using the maximum match.

In reviewing discounts, RMG takes into consideration the offering period and offering price. Because plans with “either/or” provisions reduce the market risk associated with plan purchases, we believe the maximum discount available under such plans should be 15 percent. However, RMG guidelines allow for greater discounts, up to 25 percent, for plans in which the offering price is based on the company’s share price on the date participation commences.

Limits on the Number or Value of Shares Purchasable (Participation Limits)

ESPPs must specify a limit on the number or value of shares each participant is eligible to purchase, for Section 423 Plans it is US$25,000 per year, in the United Kingdom and Ireland it is GBP 3,000 and IRP 3,000, respectively. Because the shares are discounted, there must be some limit on the ability of eligible employees to participate to prevent excessive dilution. This also limits the ability of executives to buy, via the plan, large amounts of discounted shares. Ideally, there should be a plan feature prohibiting employees who are large shareholders (5 percent in Section 423 Plans) from participating.

Loan Terms

Some plans offer participants loans to pay for the shares. If loans are part of a share purchase plan, RMG prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. RMG also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessarily warrant a recommendation against a share purchase plan, but they are taken into consideration in RMG’s analysis of the plan.

 

B-143


Table of Contents

 

Grants Outside of Plans

Resolutions asking shareholders to approve specific grants of shares or cash outside of established plans are problematic. Some companies prefer not to adopt formal share plans, instead asking shareholders to approve yearly grants to specific employees. RMG prefers that companies make such grants in the context of an established plan.

RMG’s primary concern with grants outside of plans is the level of dilution they afford. The number of shares issued as part of the grants, when combined with the number of shares reserved for the company’s other share plans, must fall within acceptable dilution limits. Vesting provisions and performance criteria are also important and are evaluated on the same basis as if the grants were part of a formal plan.

 

B-144


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Antitakeover Mechanisms

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote AGAINST all antitakeover proposals unless they are structured in such a way that they give shareholders the ultimate decision on any proposal or offer.

Discussion

Common antitakeover mechanisms include staggered boards, supervoting shares, poison pills, unlimited authorized capital authorizations (including blank check preferred stock), and golden shares. Some of these restrictions are aimed solely at limiting share ownership by foreign or unwanted minority shareholders, and others are designed to preclude an unwanted takeover of the target company by any party. RMG opposes all forms of such mechanisms, as they limit shareholder value by eliminating the takeover or control premium for the company. As owners of the company, shareholders should be given the opportunity to decide on the merits of takeover offers.

Golden Shares

Recently privatized companies around the world often include in their share structure a golden share held by their respective governments. These shares often carry special voting rights or the power of automatic veto over specific proposals. Golden shares are most common among former state-owned companies or politically sensitive industries such as utilities, railways, and airlines. While the introduction of golden shares is not a desirable governance practice, RMG recognizes the political importance certain companies hold for governments and treats the introduction or amendment of government shares on a case-by-case basis.

Supermajority Vote Requirements

Supermajority vote requirements violate the principle that a simple majority of voting shares should be all that is necessary to effect change regarding a company and its corporate governance provisions. Requiring more than this may permit management to entrench themselves by blocking provisions that are in the best interest of shareholders. However, in many world markets, supermajority vote requirements for special resolutions or EGMs are the norm, either two-thirds or three-fourths of shares voting at the meeting (either in person or by proxy). When reviewing proposals to introduce supermajority vote requirements, RMG takes into account market norms, the company’s reasons for the change, and the company’s ownership structure.

 

B-145


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Shareholder Proposals

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote all shareholder proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote FOR proposals that would improve the company’s corporate governance or business profile at a reasonable cost.

Vote AGAINST proposals that limit the company’s business activities or capabilities or result in significant costs being incurred with little or no benefit.

Discussion

RMG reviews all shareholder proposals to ascertain whether the proposal is beneficial or detrimental to shareholder value. Most resolutions fall into three basic categories: corporate governance, social, and environmental. While shareholder proposals in most countries are not as prevalent as they are in the United States, they are becoming more common, and standards for reviewing the various types of proposals are necessary.

Corporate Governance Proposals

Corporate governance-related proposals must be evaluated carefully because any changes can dramatically affect shareholder value. Support for such proposals must be measured against the likely impact that approval would have on the company’s operations. If a measure would improve disclosure of company activities in non-strategic areas and at minimal costs, RMG supports the proposal. If a proposal seeks to improve the company’s corporate governance structure, such as adopting board committees, eliminating staggered board structures, or canceling antitakeover instruments, approval is also warranted. However, if acceptance of a proposal is likely to lead to a disruption in board or management operations and to cause the company to incur significant costs without clear benefit, RMG recommends opposing the proposal.

Social and Environmental Proposals

In evaluating social and environmental proposals, RMG first determines whether or not the issue in question should be addressed on a company-specific basis. Many social and environmental issues are beyond the scope of any one company and are more properly the province of government and broader regulatory action. If this is the case, RMG recommends voting against the proposal.

Most proposals of this type require shareholders to apply subjective criteria in making their voting decision. While broader issues are of concern to everyone, institutional shareholders acting as representatives of their beneficiaries are required to consider only the ultimate interests of their direct beneficiaries. Relating the interests of their beneficiaries to the greater good can be a difficult process and a matter for individual determination. For this reason, RMG focuses on the financial aspects of social and environmental proposals. If a proposal would have a negative impact on the company’s financial position or adversely affect important operations, RMG recommends opposing the resolution. Conversely, if a proposal would have a clear and beneficial impact on the company’s finances or operations, RMG recommends supporting the proposal.

 

B-146


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 

2010 Taft-Hartley U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines

January 2010

 

 

 

Copyright © 2010 by RiskMetrics Group.

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.

Risk Management  |  RiskMetrics Labs  |  ISS Governance Services  |  Financial Research & Analysis

www.riskmetrics.com


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

  

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

     B-151   

DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

     B-151   

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

     B-152   

Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

     B-153   

Independent Directors

     B-154   

Non-Independent Chairman

     B-154   

Excessive Directorships

     B-155   

Performance/Governance Evaluation for Directors

     B-155   

Director Diversity

     B-156   

Stock Ownership Requirements

     B-157   

Classified Boards — Annual Elections

     B-157   

Board and Committee Size

     B-157   

Limit Term of Office

     B-158   

Cumulative Voting

     B-158   

Failure to Act on Shareholder Proposals Receiving Majority Support

     B-159   

Votes Against or Withholds from Directors for Shareholder Rights Plan (i.e. Poison Pills)

     B-159   

Shareholder Access to the Proxy (“Open Access”)

     B-160   

Majority Threshold Voting Requirement for Director Elections

     B-160   

Establish An Office of the Board

     B-161   

Director and Officer Indemnification ~ Liability Protection

     B-161   

Indemnification

     B-161   

COMPENSATION

     B-161   

Stock Option Plans

     B-163   

Methodology for Analyzing Pay Plans

     B-163   

Voting Power Dilution (VPD) Calculation

     B-164   

Fair Market Value, Dilution and Repricing

     B-164   

Burn Rate

     B-165   

Executive Concentration Ratio

     B-165   

Principle of Pay-For-Performance

     B-165   

Evergreen Provisions

     B-165   

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

     B-165   

Problematic Compensation Practices and Compensation Committee Performance

     B-166   

Restricted Stock

     B-168   

Executive Holding Periods

     B-168   

Performance-Based Options

     B-168   

Options Backdating

     B-169   

Pension Plan Income Accounting

     B-169   

Shareholder Proposals to Limit Executive and Director Pay

     B-169   

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Shareholder Proposals

     B-169   

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Management Proposals

     B-169   

Compensation Consultants — Disclosure of Board or Company’s Utilization

     B-170   

Golden and Tin Parachutes

     B-170   

Executive Perks and Retirement/Death Benefits

     B-170   

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

     B-171   

OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals

     B-171   

Amendments to Add Performance-Based Goals

     B-171   

Amendments to Increase Shares and Retain Tax Deductions Under OBRA

     B-171   

Approval of Cash or Cash-and-Stock Bonus Plans

     B-171   

 

B-148


Table of Contents

AUDITORS

     B-172   

Auditor Independence

     B-172   

Auditor Ratification

     B-172   

Auditor Rotation

     B-173   

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

     B-173   

Disclosures Under Section 404 of Sarbanes-Oxley Act

     B-174   

Adverse Opinions

     B-174   

TAKEOVER DEFENSES

     B-175   

Poison Pills

     B-175   

Greenmail

     B-176   

Shareholder Ability to Remove Directors

     B-176   

Shareholder Ability to Alter the Size of the Board

     B-176   

SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS

     B-176   

Confidential Voting

     B-176   

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

     B-177   

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

     B-177   

Unequal Voting Rights

     B-177   

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Amend the Charter or Bylaws

     B-177   

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Approve Mergers

     B-178   

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

     B-178   

Bundled Proposals

     B-178   

MERGERS & ACQUISITIONS/CORPORATE RESTRUCTURINGS

     B-179   

Fair Price Provisions

     B-179   

Corporate Restructuring

     B-180   

Appraisal Rights

     B-180   

Spin-offs

     B-180   

Asset Sales

     B-180   

Liquidations

     B-180   

Going Private Transactions (LBOs, Minority Squeezeouts)

     B-180   

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

     B-180   

CAPITAL STRUCTURE

     B-182   

Common Stock Authorization

     B-182   

Reverse Stock Splits

     B-182   

Blank Check Preferred Authorization

     B-182   

Adjust Par Value of Common Stock

     B-183   

Preemptive Rights

     B-183   

Debt Restructuring

     B-183   

STATE OF INCORPORATION

     B-185   

Voting on State Takeover Statutes

     B-185   

Reincorporations Proposals

     B-185   

Offshore Reincorporations and Tax Havens

     B-185   

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY & ACCOUNTABILITY

     B-186   

I.    GENERAL CSR RELATED

     B-187   

Special Policy Review and Shareholder Advisory Committees

     B-187   

Operations in Protected or Sensitive Areas

     B-187   

Land Use

     B-187   

International Financial Related

     B-187   

Affirm Political Non-Partisanship

     B-188   

Political Contributions Reporting & Disclosure

     B-188   

Military Sales

     B-189   

Report on Operations in Sensitive Regions or Countries

     B-189   

Recycling Policy

     B-189   

 

B-149


Table of Contents

II.  CLIMATE CHANGE ~ GLOBAL WARMING

     B-189   

Kyoto Compliance

     B-190   

Greenhouse Gas Emissions

     B-190   

Investment in Renewable Energy

     B-190   

Sustainability Reporting and Planning

     B-190   

Endorsement of CERES Principles

     B-191   

III. WORKPLACE PRACTICES & HUMAN RIGHTS

     B-191   

Equal Employment Opportunity

     B-191   

High-Performance Workplace

     B-192   

Non-Discrimination in Retirement Benefits

     B-192   

Fair Lending Reporting and Compliance

     B-192   

MacBride Principles

     B-193   

Contract Supplier Standards

     B-193   

Corporate Conduct and Labor Code of Conduct

     B-194   

IV. CONSUMER HEALTH & PUBLIC SAFETY

     B-194   

Phase-out or Label Products Containing Genetically Engineered Ingredients

     B-194   

Tobacco-Related Proposals

     B-194   

Toxic Emissions

     B-194   

Toxic Chemicals

     B-195   

Nuclear Safety

     B-195   

Concentrated Area Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

     B-195   

Pharmaceutical Product Reimportation

     B-195   

Pharmaceutical Product Pricing

     B-196   

 

B-150


Table of Contents

 

TAFT-HARTLEY ADVISORY SERVICES

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

This statement sets forth the proxy voting policy of RiskMetrics’ Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. The U.S. Department of Labor (DOL) has stated that the fiduciary act of managing plan assets that are shares of corporate stock includes the voting of proxies appurtenant to those shares of stock and that trustees may delegate this duty to an investment manager. ERISA section 3(38) defines an investment manager as any fiduciary who is registered as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisor Act of 1940. RiskMetrics is a registered investment adviser under the Investment Advisor Act of 1940.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote the proxies of its clients solely in the interest of their participants and beneficiaries and for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to them. The interests of participants and beneficiaries will not be subordinated to unrelated objectives. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall act with the care, skill, prudence, and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims. When proxies due to Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ clients have not been received, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will make reasonable efforts to obtain missing proxies. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is not responsible for voting proxies it does not receive.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall analyze each proxy on a case-by-case basis, informed by the guidelines elaborated below, subject to the requirement that all votes shall be cast solely in the long-term interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plans. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not intend for these guidelines to be exhaustive. Hundreds of issues appear on proxy ballots every year, and it is neither practical nor productive to fashion voting guidelines and policies which attempt to address every eventuality. Rather, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines are intended to cover the most significant and frequent proxy issues that arise. Issues not covered by the guidelines shall be voted in the interest of plan participants and beneficiaries of the plan based on a worker-owner view of long-term corporate value. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall revise its guidelines as events warrant and will remain in full conformity with the AFL-CIO proxy voting policy.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall report annually to its clients on proxy votes cast on their behalf. These proxy voting reports will demonstrate Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ compliance with its responsibilities and will facilitate clients’ monitoring of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. A copy of this Proxy Voting Policy Statement and Guidelines is provided to each client at the time Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is retained. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall provide its clients with revised copies of this proxy voting policy statement and guidelines whenever significant revisions have been made.

DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

Electing directors is the single most important stock ownership right that shareholders can exercise. By electing directors who share their views, shareholders can help to define performance standards against which management can be held accountable. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services holds directors to a high standard when voting on their election, qualifications, and compensation. We evaluate directors fairly and objectively, rewarding them for significant contributions and holding them ultimately accountable to shareholders for corporate performance. Institutional investors should use their voting rights in uncontested elections to influence financial performance and corporate strategies for achieving long term shareholder value.

Director accountability, independence and competence have become issues of prime importance to investors given the failings in oversight exposed by the global financial crisis. There is also concern over the environment in the boardrooms of certain markets, where past failures appear to be no impediment to continued or new appointments at major companies and may not be part of the evaluation process at companies in considering whether an individual is, or continues to be, fit for the role and best able to serve shareholder’s interests.

 

B-151


Table of Contents

 

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

Votes concerning the entire board of directors and members of key board committees are examined using the following five factors:

 

   

Lack of independence of the full board and key board committees (fully independent audit, compensation, and nominating committees);

 

   

Performance of the board and key board committees (flagrant actions by management or the board, excessive risk-taking, problematic governance provisions, egregious compensation practices, poor accounting practices, imprudent use of corporate assets, etc.);

 

   

Failure of the board to properly respond to high withhold/against votes or majority votes on shareholder proposals;

 

   

Poor long-term corporate performance record relative to peers, S&P 500 or Russell 3000 Indices;

 

   

Diversity of board.

Votes on individual director nominees are always made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Specific director nominee WITHHOLD/AGAINST1 votes can be triggered by one or more of the following factors:

 

   

Lack of a board that is at least two-thirds (67 percent) independent — i.e. where the composition of non-independent board members is in excess of 33 percent of the entire board;

 

   

Attendance of director nominees at board meetings of less than 75 percent in one year without valid reason or explanation;

 

   

Lack of independence on key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, and nominating committees);

 

   

Failure to establish any key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, or nominating);

 

   

Directors serving on an excessive number of other boards which could compromise their primary duties of care and loyalty;

 

   

Chapter 7 bankruptcy, Securities & Exchange Commission (SEC) violations or fines, and criminal investigations by the Department of Justice (DOJ), Government Accounting Office (GAO) or any other federal agency;

 

   

Performance of compensation committee members and/or the entire board in relation to the approval of egregious or excessive executive compensation (including perquisites and cash and equity awards);

 

   

Performance of audit committee members concerning the approval of excessive non-audit fees, material weaknesses, and/or the lack of auditor ratification upon the proxy ballot;

 

   

If at the previous board election, any director received more than 50 percent withhold/against votes of the shares cast and the company has failed to address the underlying issue(s) that caused the high withhold/against vote;

 

   

The board failed to act on takeover offers where the majority of the shareholders tendered their shares;

 

   

The board lacks accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers;

 

   

If the company has a classified board and a continuing director is responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote, in addition

 

 

1

In general, companies with a plurality vote standard use “Withhold” as the valid contrary vote option in director elections; companies with a majority vote standard use “Against”. However, it will vary by company and the proxy must be checked to determine the valid contrary vote option for the particular company.

 

B-152


Table of Contents
 

to potential future withhold/against votes on that director, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may vote against or withhold votes from any or all of the nominees up for election, with the exception of new nominees;

 

   

The presence of problematic governance issues including interlocking directorships, multiple related-party transactions or other issues putting director independence at risk;

 

   

Inadequate CEO succession planning, including the absence of an emergency and non-emergency/orderly CEO succession plan;

 

   

Material failures of governance, stewardship, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company, failure to replace management as appropriate, egregious actions related to the director(s)’ service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from the members of the Audit Committee when:

 

   

Consulting (i.e. non-audit) fees paid to the auditor are excessive;

 

   

Auditor ratification is not included on the proxy ballot;

 

   

The company receives an adverse opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditor;

 

   

There is evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm; or

 

   

Poor accounting practices such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures, exist. Poor accounting practices may warrant voting against or withholding votes from the full board.

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from the members of the Compensation Committee when:

 

   

There is a negative correlation or disconnect between the CEO’s pay and company performance;

 

   

The company implements a repricing or an option exchange program, by buying out underwater options for stock, cash or other consideration or canceling underwater options and regranting options with a lower exercise price, without prior shareholder approval, even if such repricings are allowed in its equity plans;

 

   

The company fails to submit one-time transfers of stock options to a shareholder vote;

 

   

The company fails to fulfill the terms of a burn rate commitment they made to shareholders;

 

   

The company has backdated options (see Options Backdating policy);

 

   

There is evidence that management/board members are using company stock in hedging activities

 

   

The company has problematic compensation practices such as the provision of excise tax gross-ups, single and modified single trigger provisions, liberal change in control definitions, excessive executive perks and tax gross-ups on executive perks, excessive executive pay or disproportionately high compensation payouts tied to short-term financial results, etc. (see Probematic Pay Practices policy).

Problematic pay practices may warrant voting against or withholding votes from the entire board.

Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

Contested elections of directors frequently occur when a board candidate or “dissident slate” seeks election for the purpose of achieving a significant change in corporate policy or control of seats on the board. Competing slates will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis with a number of considerations in mind. These include, but

 

B-153


Table of Contents

are not limited to, the following: personal qualifications of each candidate; the economic impact of the policies advanced by the dissident slate of nominees; and their expressed and demonstrated commitment to the interests of the shareholders of the company. Votes in a contested election of directors are evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis with the following seven factors in consideration:

 

   

Long-term financial performance of the target company relative to its industry;

 

   

Management’s track record;

 

   

Background to the proxy contest;

 

   

Qualifications of director nominees (both slates);

 

   

Strategic plan of dissident slate and quality of critique against management;

 

   

Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates);

 

   

Stock ownership positions.

Independent Directors

Board independence from management is of vital importance to a company and its shareholders. Accordingly, we believe votes should be cast in a manner that will encourage the independence of boards. Independence will be evaluated based upon a number of factors, including: employment by the company or an affiliate in an executive capacity; past or current employment by a firm that is one of the company’s paid advisors or consultants; personal services contract with the company; family relationships of an executive or director of the company; interlocks with other companies on which the company’s chairman or chief executive officer is also a board member; and service with a non-profit that receives significant contributions from the company.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from non-independent director nominees (insiders and affiliated outsiders) where the entire board is not at least two-thirds (67 percent) independent;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from non-independent director nominees (insiders and affiliated outsiders) when the nominating, compensation and audit committees are not fully independent;

 

   

Generally consider independent board members who have been on the board continually for a period longer than 10 years as affiliated outsiders;

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that all key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation and/or nominating) include independent directors exclusively;

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that the board be comprised of a two-thirds majority of independent directors.

Non-Independent Chairman

Two major components at the top of every public company are the running of the board and the executive responsibility for the running of the company’s business. Many institutional investors believe there should be a clear division of responsibilities at the head of the company that will ensure a balance of power and authority, such that no one individual has unfettered powers of decision. When there is no clear division between the executive and board branches of a company, poor executive and/or board actions often go unchecked to the ultimate detriment of shareholders. Since executive compensation is so heavily correlated to the managerial power relationship in the boardroom, the separation of the CEO and chairman positions is a critical step in curtailing excessive pay, which ultimately can become a drain on shareholder value.

Arguments have been made that a smaller company and its shareholders can benefit from the full-time attention of a joint chairman and CEO. This may be so in select cases, and indeed, using a case-by-case review of

 

B-154


Table of Contents

circumstances there may be worthy exceptions. But, even in these cases, it is the general view of many institutions that a person should only serve in the position of joint CEO and chairman on a temporary basis, and that these positions should be separated following their provisional combination.

We strongly believe that the potential for conflicts of interest in the board’s supervisory and oversight duties trumps any possible corollary benefits that could ensue from a dual CEO/chairman scenario. Instead of having an ingrained quid pro quo situation whereby a company has a single leader overseeing both management and the boardroom, Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe that it is the board’s implicit duty to assume an impartial and objective role in overseeing the executive team’s overall performance. Shareholders interests are placed in jeopardy if the CEO of a company is required to report to a board that she/he also chairs.

Inherent in the chairman’s job description is the duty to assess the CEO’s performance. This objectivity is obviously compromised when a chairman is in charge of evaluating her/his own performance or has a past or present affiliation with management. Moreover, the unification of chairman and CEO poses a direct threat to the smooth functioning of the entire board process since it is the ultimate responsibility of the chairman to set the agenda, facilitate discussion, and make sure that directors are given complete access to information in order to make informed decisions.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from any non-independent director who serves as board chairman;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from a CEO who is also serving in the role of chairman at the same company;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals calling for the separation of the CEO and chairman positions;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals calling for a non-executive director to serve as chairman who is not a former CEO or senior-level executive of the company.

Excessive Directorships

As new regulations mandate that directors be more engaged and vigilant in protecting shareholder interests or else risk civil and/or criminal sanctions, board members are having to devote more time and effort to their oversight duties which, on average, were estimated to run to 280 hours per year, per board in 2005. Recent surveys of U.S. directors also confirm a desire for limiting board memberships, to between three and five seats. In view of the increased demands placed on corporate board members, Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe that directors who are overextended may be impairing their ability to serve as effective representatives of shareholders. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against or withhold from directors serving on an excessive number of other boards, which could compromise their primary duties of care and loyalty.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from directors serving on an excessive number of boards. As a general rule, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from director nominees who are:

 

   

CEOs of publicly traded companies who serve on more than two public boards (i.e. more than one public boards other than their own board). NOTE: Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against or withhold from overboarded CEO directors only at their outside directorships and not at the company in which they presently serve as CEO); and

 

   

Non-CEO directors who serve on more than five public company boards.

Performance/Governance Evaluation for Directors

Many institutional investors believe long-term financial performance and the appropriateness of governance practices should be taken into consideration when determining vote recommendations with regard to directors in uncontested elections. When evaluating whether to vote against or withhold votes from director nominees, we

 

B-155


Table of Contents

will evaluate underperforming companies that exhibit sustained poor performance as measured by one- and three-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). For companies outside the Russell 3000 universe, a company will be considered to have exhibited sustained poor performance if it underperforms its peers or index on the basis of both one-year and three-year total shareholder returns.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services views deficient oversight mechanisms and the lack of board accountability to shareholders especially in the context of sustained poor performance, as problematic. As part of our framework for assessing director performance, we will also evaluate board accountability and oversight at companies that demonstrate sustained underperformance. A governance structure that discourages director accountability may lead to board and management entrenchment. For example, the existence of several anti-takeover provisions* has the cumulative effect of deterring legitimate tender offers, mergers, and corporate transactions that may have ultimately proved beneficial to shareholders. When a company maintains entrenchment devices, shareholders of poorly performing companies are left with few effective routes to beneficial change.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will assess the company’s response to the ongoing performance issues, and consider recent board and management changes, board independence, overall governance practices, and other factors that may have an impact on shareholders. If a company exhibits sustained poor performance coupled with a lack of board accountability and oversight, we may also consider the company’s five-year total shareholder return and five-year operational metrics in our evaluation.

*Problematic provisions include but are not limited to:

 

   

a classified board structure; o a supermajority vote requirement;

 

   

majority voting with no carve out for contested elections;

 

   

the inability for shareholders to call special meetings;

 

   

the inability for shareholders to act by written consent;

 

   

a dual-class structure; and/or

 

   

a non-shareholder approved poison pill.

Vote AGAINST/WITHHOLD votes from all director nominees if the board lacks accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers. Sustained poor performance is measured by one- and three-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). Sustained poor performance for companies outside the Russell 3000 universe, is defined as underperforming peers or index on the basis of both one-year and three-year total shareholder returns.

Director Diversity

Gender and ethnic diversity are important components on a company’s board. Diversity brings different perspectives to a board that in turn leads to a more varied approach to board issues. Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe that increasing diversity in the boardroom to better reflect a company’s workforce, customers, and community enhances shareholder value.

 

   

Support proposals asking the board to make greater efforts to search for qualified female and minority candidates for nomination to the board of directors;

 

   

Support endorsement of a policy of board inclusiveness;

 

   

Support reporting to shareholders on a company’s efforts to increase diversity on their boards.

 

B-156


Table of Contents

 

Stock Ownership Requirements

Corporate directors should own some amount of stock of the companies on which they serve as board members. Stock ownership is a simple method to align the interests of directors with company shareholders. Nevertheless, many highly qualified individuals such as academics and clergy who can offer valuable perspectives in boardrooms may be unable to purchase individual shares of stock. In such a circumstance, the preferred solution is to look at the board nominees individually and take stock ownership into consideration when voting on the merits of each candidate.

 

   

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals requiring directors to own a minimum amount of company stock in order to qualify as a director nominee or to remain on the board.

Classified Boards — Annual Elections

The ability to elect directors is the single most important use of the shareholder franchise, and all directors should be accountable on an annual basis. Annually elected boards provide the best governance system for accountability to shareholders. A classified board is a board that is divided into separate classes, with directors serving overlapping terms. A company with a classified board usually divides the board into three classes. Under this system, only one class of nominees comes up to shareholder vote at the AGM each year.

As a consequence of these staggered terms, shareholders only have the opportunity to vote on a single director approximately once every three years. A classified board makes it difficult to change control of the board through a proxy contest since it would normally take two years to gain control of a majority of board seats. Under a classified board, the possibility of management entrenchment greatly increases. Classified boards can reduce director accountability by shielding directors, at least for a certain period of time, from the consequences of their actions. Continuing directors who are responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level would avoid shareholders’ reactions to their actions because they would not be up for election in that year. Ultimately, in these cases, the full board should be responsible for the actions of its directors.

Many in management believe that staggered boards provide continuity. Some shareholders believe that in certain cases a staggered board can provide consistency and continuity in regard to decision-making and commitment that may be important to the long-term financial future of the company. Nevertheless, empirical evidence strongly suggests that staggered boards are generally not in the shareholders’ best interest. In addition to shielding directors from being held accountable by shareholders on an annual basis, a classified board can entrench management and effectively preclude most takeover bids or proxy contests.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management or shareholder proposals seeking to classify the board when the issue comes up for vote;

 

   

Vote FOR management or shareholder proposals to repeal a company’s classified board structure.

 

   

If the company has a classified board and a continuing director is responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote, in addition to potential future withhold/against votes on that director, we may vote against or withhold votes from any or all of the nominees up for election, with the exception of new nominees.

Board and Committee Size

While there is no hard and fast rule among institutional investors as to what may be an optimal size board, there is an acceptable range that companies should strive to meet and not exceed. A board that is too large may function inefficiently. Conversely, a board that is too small may allow the CEO to exert disproportionate influence or may stretch the time requirements of individual directors too thin.

 

B-157


Table of Contents

 

Proposals seeking to set board size will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Given that the preponderance of boards in the U.S. range between five and fifteen directors, many institutional investors believe this benchmark is a useful standard for evaluating such proposals.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST any proposal seeking to amend the company’s board size to fewer than five seats;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST any proposal seeking to amend the company’s board size to more than fifteen seats;

 

   

Evaluate board size on a CASE-BY-CASE basis and consider WITHHOLD or AGAINST votes or other action at companies that have fewer than five directors and more than 15 directors on their board.

Limit Term of Office

Those who support term limits argue that this requirement would bring new ideas and approaches on to a board. While term of office limitations can rid the board of non-performing directors over time, it can also unfairly force experienced and effective directors off the board. When evaluating shareholder proposals on director term limits, consider whether the company’s performance has been poor and whether problematic or entrenching governance provisions are in place at the company. Additionally, consider board independence, including whether the board chair is independent.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors.

Cumulative Voting

Most corporations provide that shareholders are entitled to cast one vote for each share owned. Under a cumulative voting scheme, the shareholder is permitted to have one vote per share for each director to be elected. Shareholders are permitted to apportion those votes in any manner they wish among the director candidates. Thus, under a cumulative voting scheme shareholders have the opportunity to elect a minority representative to a board by cumulating their votes, thereby ensuring minority representation for all sizes of shareholders.

For example, if there is a company with a ten-member board and 500 shares outstanding-the total number of votes that may be cast is 5,000. In this case a shareholder with 51 shares (10.2 percent of the outstanding shares) would be guaranteed one board seat because all votes may be cast for one candidate. Without cumulative voting, anyone controlling 51 percent of shares would control the election of all ten directors.

With the advent and prevalence of majority voting for director elections, shareholders now have greater flexibility in supporting candidates for a company’s board of directors. Cumulative voting and majority voting are two different voting mechanisms designed to achieve two different outcomes. While cumulative voting promotes the interests of minority shareholders by allowing them to get some representation on the board, majority voting promotes a democratic election of directors for all shareholders and ensures board accountability in uncontested elections. Though different in philosophic view, cumulative voting and majority voting can work together operationally, with companies electing to use majority voting for uncontested elections and cumulative voting for contested elections to increase accountability and ensure minority representation on the board.

In contested elections, similar to cumulative voting, proxy access allows shareholder access to the ballot without a veto from the nominating committee, but unlike cumulative voting, it also requires majority support to elect such directors.

At controlled companies, where majority insider control would preclude minority shareholders from having any representation on the board, cumulative voting would allow such representation and shareholder proposals for cumulative voting would be supported.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to eliminate cumulative voting;

 

B-158


Table of Contents

 

   

Generally vote FOR proposals to restore or provide for cumulative voting unless:

 

   

The company has proxy access or a similar structure2 to allow shareholders to nominate directors to the company’s ballot; and

 

   

The company has adopted a majority vote standard, with a carve-out for plurality voting in situations where there are more nominees than seats, and a director resignation policy to address failed elections.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals for cumulative voting at controlled companies (where insider voting power exceeds 50%).

Failure to Act on Shareholder Proposals Receiving Majority Support

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from all director nominees at a company that has ignored a shareholder proposal that was approved by a majority of the votes cast at the last annual meeting.

Votes Against or Withholds from Directors for Shareholder Rights Plan (i.e. Poison Pills)

Institutional investors view shareholder rights plans, or poison pills, as among the most onerous of takeover defenses that may serve to entrench management and have a detrimental impact on their long-term share value. While recognizing that boards have a fiduciary duty to use all available means to protect shareholders’ interests, as a best governance principle, boards should seek shareholder ratification of a poison pill (or an amendment thereof) within a reasonable period, to ensure that the features of the poison pill support the interests of shareholders and do not merely serve as a management entrenchment device. Boards that fail to do so should be held accountable for ultimately disregarding shareholders’ interests. In applying this principle to voting in uncontested director elections, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services considers the term of the pill an important factor, as shorter term pills are generally less onerous as a takeover defense when compared to longer term pills, and may in some cases provide the board with a valuable tool to maximize shareholder value in the event of an opportunistic offer.

Companies that unilaterally adopt a long-term pill should be subject to a more frequent review –- at least once every three years, beginning the first year following the adoption and extending until the pill has expired or been redeemed. However, we believe special consideration must be given to the combination of a poison pill and a classified board; together they create a powerful anti-takeover and entrenchment device. Instead of only reviewing such companies every 3 years, an annual review is more appropriate. Under a 3-year review, the same class of directors would be receiving against or withhold recommendations, while the other 2 classes of directors would be shielded. An annual review would hold responsible all directors of classified boards for not putting the pill to a shareholder vote.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees of the board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis) at a company that has a dead-hand or modified dead-hand poison pill in place. Vote AGAINST/WITHHOLD every year until this feature is removed;

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees of the board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis) if the board has adopted a poison pill with a term of more than 12 months (“long-term pill” ) or renewed any existing pill, including any “short-term” pill (12 months or less) without shareholder approval, and there is no requirement or commitment to put the pill to a binding shareholder vote. Review such companies with classified

 

 

2

A similar structure would be a structure that allows shareholders to nominate candidates who the company will include on the management ballot in addition to management’s nominees, and their bios are included in management’s proxy.

 

B-159


Table of Contents
 

boards every year, and such companies with annually-elected boards at least once every three years, and vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees if the company still maintains a non-shareholder-approved poison pill;

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees of the board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis) if the board makes a material, adverse change to an existing poison pill without shareholder approval;

 

   

Vote CASE-By-CASE on all nominees if the board adopts a poison pill with a term of 12 months or less (“short-term pill”) without shareholder approval, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

The date of the pill’s adoption relative to the date of next meeting of shareholders — i.e. whether the company had time to put the pill on ballot for shareholder ratification given the circumstances;

 

   

The issuer’s rationale;

 

   

The issuer’s governance structure and practices; and

 

   

The issuer’s track record of accountability to shareholders.

Shareholder Access to the Proxy (“Open Access”)

The current director election process as it exists leaves much to be desired. Companies currently nominate for election only one candidate for each board seat. Shareholders who oppose a candidate have no easy way to do so unless they are willing to undertake the considerable expense of running an independent candidate for the board. The only way for shareholders to register symbolic dissent about a certain director candidate is to simply “withhold” support from that nominee. But because directors are typically elected by a plurality (those nominees receiving the most votes win board seats), company nominees running unopposed are reelected.

 

   

Consider on a CASE-BY-CASE basis reasonably crafted shareholder proposals asking companies to voluntarily provide shareholders the ability to nominate director candidates to be included on management’s proxy card, taking into account the ownership threshold proposed in the resolution. Special consideration will be made at companies where there are legitimate concerns surrounding responsiveness to shareholders (such as not implementing majority-supported shareholder proposals), board and key committee independence, problematic governance and compensation practices, and past accounting or financial issues such as restatements.

Majority Threshold Voting Requirement for Director Elections

Shareholders have expressed strong support for precatory resolutions on majority threshold voting since 2005, with a number of proposals receiving majority support from shareholders. Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe shareholders should have a greater voice in regard to the election of directors and view majority threshold voting as a viable alternative to the current deficiencies of the plurality system in the U.S.

 

   

Generally support reasonably crafted shareholders proposals calling for directors to be elected with an affirmative majority of votes cast and/or the elimination of the plurality standard for electing directors (including binding resolutions requesting that the board amend the company’s bylaws), provided the proposal includes a carve-out for a plurality voting standard when there are more director nominees than board seats (e.g. in contested elections).

 

   

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may recommend withhold/against votes on members of the board at companies without the carve-out for plurality voting in contested elections, as the use of a majority vote standard can act as an anti-takeover defense in contested elections. (e.g. although the dissident nominees may have received more shares cast, as long as the combination of withhold/against votes and the votes for the management nominees keep the dissident nominees under 50%, the management nominees will win, due to the holdover rules). This is clearly contradicts the expressed will of shareholders.

 

B-160


Table of Contents

 

   

In addition to supporting proposals seeking a majority vote standard in director elections, we also support a post-election “director resignation policy” that addresses the situation of holdover directors to accommodate both shareholder proposals and the need for stability and continuity of the board.

Establish An Office of the Board

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholders proposals requesting that the board establish an Office of the Board of Directors in order to facilitate direct communication between shareholders and non-management directors, unless the company has effectively demonstrated via public disclosure that it already has an established structure in place.

Director and Officer Indemnification ~ Liability Protection

Management proposals typically seek shareholder approval to adopt an amendment to the company’s charter to eliminate or limit the personal liability of directors to the company and its shareholders for monetary damages for any breach of fiduciary duty to the fullest extent permitted by state law. In contrast, shareholder proposals seek to provide for personal monetary liability for fiduciary breaches arising from gross negligence.

Each proposal addressing director liability will be evaluated consistent with this philosophy. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may support these proposals when the company persuasively argues that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but we may often oppose management proposals and support shareholder proposals in order to promote greater director accountability.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to limit or eliminate entirely director and officer liability in regards to: (i) breach of the director’s fiduciary “duty of loyalty” to shareholders; (ii) acts or omissions not made in “good faith” or involving intentional misconduct or knowledge of violations under the law; (iii) acts involving the unlawful purchases or redemptions of stock; (iv) payment of unlawful dividends; or (v) use of the position as director for receipt of improper personal benefits.

Indemnification

Indemnification is the payment by a company of the expenses of directors who become involved in litigation as a result of their service to a company. Proposals to indemnify a company’s directors differ from those to eliminate or reduce their liability because with indemnification directors may still be liable for an act or omission, but the company will bear the expense. Taft-Hartley fiduciaries may support these proposals when the company persuasively argues that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but will generally oppose indemnification when it is being proposed to insulate directors from actions that have already occurred.

 

   

Vote AGAINST indemnification proposals that would expand individual coverage beyond ordinary legal expenses to also cover specific acts of negligence which exceed the standard of mere carelessness that is regularly covered in board fiduciary indemnification;

 

   

Vote FOR only those proposals which provide expanded coverage in cases when a director’s or officer’s legal defense was unsuccessful if: (1) the director was found to have acted in good faith and in a manner that he/she reasonably believed was in the best interests of the company; and (2) only if the director’s legal expenses would be covered.

COMPENSATION

The housing market collapse and resulting credit crisis have resulted in significant erosion of shareholder value, unprecedented levels of market volatility, and continuing lack of confidence among financial market participants. Many Taft-Hartley trustees are questioning the role of executive compensation in incentivizing inappropriate or excessive risk-taking behavior by executives that could threaten a corporation’s long-term viability. Further, generous severance packages and other payments to departing executives of failed institutions have heightened attention on the issue of pay for performance.

 

B-161


Table of Contents

 

Trustees of Taft-Hartley funds, which have lost significant value in their investments as a result of the financial crisis, have little patience for “pay for failure” and continue to press for the adoption of executive compensation practices aimed at creating and sustaining long-term shareholder value.

Companies have long argued that legally binding executive compensation obligations cannot be modified. The Capital Purchase Program implemented under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, the “bail out” program for the U.S. financial system, set the tone for executive compensation reform and requires participating firms to accept certain limits and requirements on executive compensation, regardless of existing contractual arrangements. A number of firms have agreed to these requirements.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that executive pay programs should be fair, competitive, reasonable, and appropriate, and that pay for performance should be a central tenet in executive compensation philosophy.

Examples of best pay practices include:

Employment contracts: Companies should enter into employment contracts under limited circumstances for a short time period (e.g., new executive hires for a three-year contract) for limited executives. The contracts should not have automatic renewal feature and should have a specified termination date.

Severance agreements: Severance provisions should not be so appealing that they become an incentive for the executive to be terminated. The severance formula should be reasonable and not overly generous to the executive (e.g., use maximum severance multiple of 3X pay; use pro-rated target/average historical bonus and not maximum bonus). Failure to renew employment contract, termination under questionable events or for poor performance should not constitute “good reason” for termination with severance payments.

Change-in-control payments: Change-in-control payments should be “double-triggered” — i.e. be payouts should only made when there is a significant change in company ownership structure, and when there is a loss of employment or substantial change in job duties associated with the change in company ownership structure. Change-in-control provisions should exclude excise tax gross-ups and should not authorize the acceleration of vesting of equity awards upon a change in control unless provided under a double-trigger scenario. Similarly, change in control provisions in equity plans should be double-triggered. A change in control event should not result in an acceleration of vesting of all unvested stock options or lapsing of vesting/performance requirements on restricted stock/performance shares, unless there is a loss of employment or substantial change in job duties.

Supplemental executive retirement plans (SERPs): SERPs should not include sweeteners that can increase the payout value significantly or even exponentially, such as additional years of service credited for pension calculations, or inclusion of variable pay (e.g. bonuses and equity awards) into the formula. Pension formulas should not include extraordinary annual bonuses paid close to the time of retirement and should be based on an average, not the maximum, level of compensation earned.

Deferred compensation: Above-market returns or guaranteed minimum returns should not be applied on deferred compensation.

Disclosure practices: The Compensation, Discussion and Analysis should be written in plain English, with as little “legalese” as possible and formatted using section headers, bulleted lists, tables and charts where possible to ease reader comprehension. Ultimately, the document should provide detail and rationale regarding compensation, strategy, pay mix, goals/metrics, challenges, competition and pay for performance linkage, etc. in a narrative fashion.

Responsible use of company stock: Companies should adopt policies that prohibit executives from speculating in company’s stock or using company stock in hedging activities, such as “cashless” collars, forward

 

B-162


Table of Contents

sales, equity swaps or other similar arrangements. Such behavior undermines the ultimate alignment with long-term shareholders’ interests. In addition, the policy should prohibit or discourage the use of company stock as collateral for margin loans, to avoid any potential sudden stock sales (required upon margin calls) that could have a negative impact on the company’s stock price.

Long-term focus: Executive compensation programs should be designed to support companies’ long-term strategic goals. A short-term focus on performance does not necessarily create sustainable shareholder value. Instead, long-term goals may be sacrificed to achieve short-term expectations to the detriment of shareholder value, as evidenced by the financial crisis.

Compensation programs embedding a long-term focus with respect to company goals better align with the long-term interests of shareholders. Granting stock options and restricted stock to executives that vest in five years does not necessarily provide a long-term focus, as executives can sell off the company shares once they vest. However, requiring senior executives to hold company stock until retirement or after retirement can encourage a long-term focus on company performance.

Stock Option Plans

Compensation to executive and other senior level employees should be strongly correlated to sustained performance. Stock options, restricted stock and other forms of non-cash compensation should be performance-based with an eye toward improving long-term corporate value. Well-designed stock option plans can align the interests of executives and shareholders by providing that executives benefit when stock prices rise so that the employees of the company, along with shareholders, prosper together. Likewise, option plans should not allow for the benefits of share price gains without the risk of share price declines. Poorly designed stock option plans can encourage excessive risk-taking behavior and incentivize executives to pursue corporate strategies that promote short-term stock price to the ultimate detriment of long-term shareholder value.

Many plans sponsored by management provide goals so easily attained that executives can realize massive rewards even though shareholder value is not created. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports option plans when they provide legitimately challenging performance targets that serve to truly motivate executives in the pursuit of sustained superior performance. Moreover, equity pay plans should be designed in a fashion that ensures executive compensation is veritably performance driven and “at risk” such that executives are penalized (by either reducing or withholding compensation) for failure to meet pre-determined performance hurdles. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose those plans that offer unreasonable benefits to executives that are not generally available to other shareholders or employees.

Methodology for Analyzing Pay Plans

The theory that stock options are beneficial to shareholders because they motivate management and align the interests of investors with those of executives is no longer held sacrosanct. Indeed, many academic studies have found that there is limited correlation between executive stock ownership and company performance. Misused stock options can give executives an incentive to inflate their company’s earnings, take excessive risks, and make irresponsibly optimistic forecasts in order to keep stock prices high and their paychecks gargantuan.

Therefore, it is vital for shareholders to fully analyze all equity plans that appear on ballot. In general, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services evaluates executive and director compensation plans on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. When evaluating equity-based compensation items on ballot, the following elements will be considered:

Primary Considerations:

 

   

Dilution: Vote AGAINST plans in which the potential voting power dilution (VPD) of all shares outstanding exceeds ten percent;

 

B-163


Table of Contents
   

Full Market Value: Awards must be granted at 100 percent of fair market value on the date of grant. However, in instances when a plan is open to broad-based employee participation and excludes the five most highly compensated employees, we accept a 15 percent discount;

 

   

Burn Rate: Vote AGAINST plans where the annual burn rate exceeds industry and index burn rates over a three-year period;

 

   

Liberal Definition of Change-in-Control: Vote AGAINST equity plans if the plan provides for the accelerated vesting of equity awards even though an actual change in control may not occur. Examples of such a definition could include, but are not limited to, announcement or commencement of a tender offer, provisions for acceleration upon a “potential” takeover, shareholder approval of a merger or other transactions, or similar language;

 

   

Problematic Pay Practices: Vote AGAINST equity plans if the plan is a vehicle for problematic pay practices (e.g. if the plan allows for change-in-control payouts that are single triggered).

Secondary Considerations:

 

   

Executive Concentration Ratio: Vote AGAINST plans where the annual grant rate to the top five executives (“named officers”) exceeds one percent of shares outstanding;

 

   

Pay-For-Performance Metric: Vote AGAINST plans where CEO pay and the company’s performance is incongruous, as measured against industry peers over one and three-year periods, or if the performance criteria is not disclosed;

 

   

Evergreen Features: Vote AGAINST plans that reserve a specified percentage of outstanding shares for award each year instead of having a termination date;

 

   

Repricing: Vote AGAINST plans if the company’s policy permits repricing of “underwater” options or if the company has a history of repricing past options;

 

   

Loans: Vote AGAINST the plan if the plan administrator may provide loans to officers to assist in exercising the awards.

Voting Power Dilution (VPD) Calculation

Voting power dilution, or VPD, measures the amount of voting power represented by the number of shares reserved over the life of the plan. Industry norm dictates that ten percent dilution over the life of a ten-year plan is reasonable for most mature companies. Restricted stock plans or stand-alone stock bonus plans that are not coupled with stock option plans can be held to a lower dilution cap.

Voting power dilution may be calculated using the following formula:

 

  A: Shares reserved for this amendment or plan;

 

  B: Shares available under this plan and/or continuing plans prior to proposed amendment;

 

  C: Shares granted but unexercised under this plan and/or continuing plans;

 

  D: All outstanding shares plus any convertible equity, outstanding warrants, or debt.

 

The formula can be applied as follows:

      A + B + C    
  A + B + C + D

Fair Market Value, Dilution and Repricing

Consideration will be made as to whether the proposed plan is being offered at fair market value or at a discount; whether the plan excessively dilutes the earnings per share of the outstanding shares; and whether the plan gives management the ability to replace or reprice “underwater” options. Repricing is an amendment to a

 

B-164


Table of Contents

previously granted stock option contract that reduces the option exercise price. Options are “underwater” when their current price is below the current option contract price. Options can also be repriced through cancellations and re-grants. The typical new grant would have a ten-year term, new vesting restrictions, and a lower exercise price reflecting the current lower market price.

Burn Rate

The annual burn rate is a measure of dilution that illustrates how rapidly a company is deploying shares reserved for equity compensation plans. The burn or run rate is calculated by dividing the number of shares pursuant to awards granted in a given year by the number of shares outstanding. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services benchmarks a company’s burn rate against three-year industry and primary index burn rates, and generally oppose plans whose average three-year burn rates exceed the greater of: (1) the mean plus one standard deviation of the company’s GICS group segmented by Russell 3000 index and non-Russell 3000 index; or (2) two percent of weighted common shares outstanding. The three-year burn rate policy does not apply to non-employee director plans unless outside directors receive a significant portion of shares each year.

Executive Concentration Ratio

In examining stock option awards, restricted stock and other forms of long-term incentives, it is important to consider internal pay equity; that is, the concentration and distribution of equity awards to a company’s top five executives (“named officers”) as a percentage of overall grants. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider voting against equity compensation plans whose annual grant rate to top executives exceeds one percent of shares outstanding.

Principle of Pay-For-Performance

Stock-based pay is often the main driver for excessive executive compensation, which is fueled by poor administration of the plan. Therefore, it is important to closely examine any discrepancies between increases in CEO pay and total shareholder returns against those of peer firms over a one- three- and five-year timeframe in assessing equity-based compensation plans.

Significant disparities between pay and performance warrants votes against or withholding from Compensation Committee members who are responsible for overseeing the company’s compensation schemes, or the entire board if the whole board was involved in and contributed to egregious compensation practices. If the equity component is the source of the imbalance, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider opposing the equity plan in which the CEO participates.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from the Compensation Committee members when the company has a pay-for-performance disconnect.

Evergreen Provisions

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose plans that reserve a specified percentage of outstanding shares for award each year (evergreen plans) instead of having a termination date. Such plans provide for an automatic increase in the shares available for grant with or without limits on an annual basis. Because they represent a transfer of shareholder value and have a dilutive impact on a regular basis, evergreen plans are expensive to shareholders. Evergreen features also minimize the frequency that companies seek shareholder approval in increasing the number of shares available under the plan.

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on management proposals seeking approval to exchange/reprice options taking into consideration the following factors:

 

   

Historic trading patterns: the stock price should not be so volatile that the options are likely to be back “in-the-money” over the near term;

 

B-165


Table of Contents

 

   

Rationale for the re-pricing: was the stock price decline beyond management’s control?

 

   

Option vesting: does the new option vest immediately or is there a black-out period?

 

   

Term of the option: the term should remain the same as that of the replaced option;

 

   

Exercise price: should be set at fair market or a premium to market;

 

   

Participants: the plan should be broad-based and executive officers and directors should be excluded;

 

   

Is this a value-for-value exchange?

 

   

Are surrendered stock options added back to the plan reserve?

If the surrendered options are added back to the equity plans for re-issuance, then we will also take into consideration the impact on the company’s equity plans and its three-year average burn rate.

In addition to the above considerations, we will evaluate the intent, rationale, and timing of the repricing proposal. The proposal should clearly articulate why the board is choosing to conduct an exchange program at this point in time. Repricing underwater options after a recent precipitous drop in the company’s stock price demonstrates poor timing. We do not view market deterioration, in and of itself, as an acceptable reason for companies to reprice stock options and/or reset goals under performance plans. Repricing after a recent decline in stock price triggers additional scrutiny and may warrant a vote AGAINST the proposal. At a minimum, the decline should not have happened within the past year. Also, consider the terms of the surrendered options, such as the grant date, exercise price and vesting schedule. Grant dates of surrendered options should be far enough back (two to three years) so as not to suggest that repricings are being done to take advantage of short-term downward price movements. Similarly, the exercise price of surrendered options should be above the 52-week high for the stock price.

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

Problematic Compensation Practices and Compensation Committee Performance

Poor disclosure, the absence or non-transparency of disclosure and poor plan design of compensation payouts lead to excessive executive compensation practices that are detrimental to shareholders. Poorly designed plans or those lacking in transparency can be reflective of a poorly performing compensation committee.

Companies are expected to meet a minimum standard of tally sheet disclosure as to allow shareholders to readily assess the total executive pay package, understand the actual linkage between pay and performance, and mitigate misinformation to shareholders. The SEC has issued rules on executive and director compensation that require expansive disclosure and a total compensation figure for each of the named executive officers.

Executive compensation will continue to be in the spotlight in the ensuing years, particularly when shareholders will have access to more complete information. In the absence of disclosure that would necessitate a higher level of scrutiny, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may also consider voting against or withholding from the compensation committee for failure to provide pertinent information in the Comensasion Discussion and Analysis (CD&A) report.

 

   

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider voting AGAINST or WITHHOLDING votes from compensation committee members and/or the CEO on a CASE-BY-CASE basis if the company has problematic compensation practices. In addition, we may consider a vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD vote from the entire board if the whole board was involved in and contributed to egregious compensation. Problematic compensation practices include, but are not limited to, the following:

Non-Performance based Compensation Elements

 

   

Multi-year guarantees for salary increases, non-performance based bonuses, and equity compensation;

 

B-166


Table of Contents

 

   

Egregious SERP (Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans) payouts (e.g. inclusion of additional years of service not earned or inclusion of performance-based equity awards in the pension calculation);

 

   

Excessive perks for current, former and/or retired executives (e.g. personal use of corporate aircraft, personal security systems maintenance and/or installation, car allowances, extraordinary relocation benefits, and/or other inappropriate arrangements);

 

   

Income tax reimbursements (gross-ups) for any executive perquisites or other payments;

 

   

Excessive severance and/or change-in-control provisions (e.g. payments upon an executive’s termination in connection with performance failure, provisions for the payment of excise tax gross-ups (including modified gross-ups) and/or modified single-triggers — under which an executive may voluntarily depart for any reason and still receive change-in-control severance payments — );

 

   

Change-in-control payouts without loss of job or substantial diminution of job duties (“single-triggers”);

 

   

Liberal change-in-control definitions in individual contracts or equity plans which could result in payments to executives without an actual change in control occurring;

 

   

Payment of dividends or dividend equivalents on unvested/unearned performance awards;

 

   

Executives using company stock in hedging activities, such as “cashless” collars, forward sales, equity swaps or other similar arrangements;

 

   

Repricing or replacing of underwater stock options/stock appreciation rights without prior shareholder approval (including cash buyouts and voluntary surrender/subsequent regrant of underwater options);

 

   

Performance metrics that are changed, canceled or replaced during the performance period without adequate explanation of the action and the link to performance;

 

   

New CEO with overly generous new hire package (e.g., including excessive “make whole” provisions).

Incentives that may Motivate Excessive Risk-Taking

 

   

Guaranteed bonuses or other abnormally large bonus payouts without justifiable performance linkage or appropriate disclosure;

 

   

Mega annual equity grants that provide unlimited upside with no downside risk;

 

   

A single performance metric used for short- and long-term plans;

 

   

High pay opportunities relative to industry peers;

 

   

Disproportionate supplemental pensions.

Factors that potentially mitigate the impact of risky incentives include rigorous claw-back provisions, robust stock ownership/holding guidelines, and substantive bonus deferral/escrowing programs.

Other Problematic Practices

 

   

Poor Disclosure Practices (e.g. unclear explanation of how the CEO is involved in the pay setting process, retrospective performance targets and methodology not discussed, methodology for benchmarking practices and/or peer group not disclosed and explained);

 

   

Internal pay disparity (excessive differential between CEO total pay and that of next highest-paid named executive officer);

 

B-167


Table of Contents

 

   

Options backdating (covered in a separate policy);

 

   

Failure to respond to majority-supported shareholder proposals on executive pay topics;

 

   

Failure to respond to concerns raised in connection with significant opposition to Management Say on Pay proposals.

Moreover, if there is an equity plan proposal on the ballot and the plan is a vehicle for poor pay practices, we may consider voting against the proposal based on past compensation practices.

Restricted Stock

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the use of performance-vesting restricted stock as long as the absolute amount of restricted stock being granted is a reasonable proportion of an executive’s overall compensation. The best way to align the interests of executives with shareholders is through direct stock holdings, coupled with at-risk variable compensation that is tied to explicit and challenging performance benchmarks. Performance-vesting restricted stock both adds to executives direct share holdings and incorporates at-risk features.

To reward performance and not job tenure, restricted stock vesting requirements should be performance-based rather than time lapsing. Such plans should explicitly define the performance criteria for awards to senior executives and may include a variety of corporate performance measures in addition to the use of stock price targets. In addition, executives should be required to hold their vested restricted stock as long as they remain employees of the company.

Executive Holding Periods

Senior level executives should be required to hold a substantial portion of their equity compensation awards, including shares received from option exercises (e.g. 75% of their after-tax stock option proceeds), while they are employed at a company or even into retirement. Equity compensation awards are intended to align management interests with those of shareholders, and allowing executives to sell these shares while they are employees of the company undermines this purpose. Given the large size of a typical annual equity compensation award, holding requirements that are based on a multiple of cash compensation may be inadequate.

Performance-Based Options

Stock options are intended to align the interests of management with those of shareholders. However, stock option grants without performance-based elements can excessively compensate executives for stock increases due solely to a general stock market rise, rather than improved or superior company stock performance. When option grants reach the hundreds of thousands, a relatively small increase in the share price may permit executives to reap millions of dollars without providing material benefits to shareholders.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services advocates for performance-based awards — such as premium-priced or indexed — which encourage executives to outperform peers, certain indices, or the broader market rather than being rewarded for any minimal rise in the share price, which can occur if there are not empirical performance measures incorporated into the structure of the options. Additionally, it should be noted that performance-accelerated vesting and premium priced options allow fixed plan accounting, whereas performance-vested and indexed options entail certain expensing requirements.

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals that seek to provide for performance-based options such as indexed and/or premium priced options.

 

B-168


Table of Contents

 

Options Backdating

Options backdating has serious implications and has resulted in financial restatements, delisting of companies, and/or the termination of executives or directors. When options backdating has taken place, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may recommend voting AGAINST or WITHHOLDING from the compensation committee, depending on the severity of the practices and the subsequent corrective actions on the part of the board. We will adopt a CASE-BY-CASE approach to the options backdating issue to differentiate companies that had sloppy administration vs. those that had committed fraud, as well as those companies which have since taken corrective action. Instances in which companies have committed fraud are more disconcerting, and Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will look to them to adopt formal policies to ensure that such practices will not reoccur in the future.

In recommending votes against or withhold votes from the compensation committee members who oversaw the questionable options grant practices or from current compensation committee members who fail to respond to the issue proactively, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider several factors, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Reason and motive for the options backdating issue, such as inadvertent vs. deliberate grant date changes;

 

   

Duration of options backdating;

 

   

Size of restatement due to options backdating;

 

   

Corrective actions taken by the board or compensation committee, such as canceling or repricing backdated options, or recoupment of option gains on backdated grants;

 

   

Adoption of a grant policy that prohibits backdating, and creation of a fixed grant schedule or window period for equity grants going forward.

Pension Plan Income Accounting

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals to exclude pension plan income in the calculation of earnings used in determining executive bonuses/compensation.

Shareholder Proposals to Limit Executive and Director Pay

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals that seek additional disclosure of executive and director pay information;

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals that seek to eliminate outside directors’ retirement benefits;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all other shareholder proposals that seek to limit executive and director pay. This includes shareholder proposals that seek to link executive compensation to customer, employee, or stakeholder satisfaction.

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Shareholder Proposals

 

   

Generally, vote FOR shareholder proposals that call for non-binding shareholder ratification of the compensation of the Named Executive Officers and the accompanying narrative disclosure of material factors provided to understand the Summary Compensation Table.

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Management Proposals

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on management proposals for an advisory vote on executive compensation, considering the following factors:

 

   

Evaluation of performance metrics in short-term and long-term plans, considering i) the measures, goals, and target awards reported by the company for executives’ short- and long-term incentive

 

B-169


Table of Contents
 

awards; ii) whether the metrics are disclosed; iii) whether the company explains their alignment with the company’s business strategy; and iv) whether the goals appear to be sufficiently challenging in relation to resulting payouts.

 

   

Evaluation of peer group benchmarking used to set target pay or award opportunities, including i) the rationale stated by the company for constituents in its pay benchmarking peer group; and ii) as the benchmark targets it uses to set or validate executives’ pay.

 

   

Balance of performance-based versus non-performance-based pay, considering i) the ratio of performance-based versus non-performance-based CEO pay elements; ii) presence of concerns about other compensation factors such as performance metrics/goals, benchmarking practices, and pay-for-performance disconnects.

 

   

Prescence of problematic pay practices (see Problematic Compensation Practices above)

 

   

Poor compensation disclosure practices.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management say on pay proposals where there is a misalignment between CEO pay and company performance, the company maintains problematic pay practices, the board exhibits poor communication and responsiveness to shareholders or if the board has failed to demonstrate good stewardship of investors’ interests regarding executive compensation practices.

Compensation Consultants — Disclosure of Board or Company’s Utilization

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking disclosure regarding the Company, Board, or Compensation Committee’s use of compensation consultants, such as company name, business relationship(s) and fees paid.

Golden and Tin Parachutes

Golden parachutes are designed to protect the employees of a corporation in the event of a change-in-control. Under most golden parachute agreements, senior level management employees receive a lump sum payout triggered by a change-in-control at usually two to three times their current base salary. Increasingly, companies that have golden parachute agreements for senior level executives are extending coverage for all their employees via “tin” parachutes. The SEC requires disclosure of all golden parachute arrangements in the proxy statement, while disclosure of tin parachutes in company filings is not required at this time.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to all have golden parachute agreements submitted for shareholder ratification;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST all proposals to ratify golden parachutes;

 

   

Vote on tin parachutes on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Executive Perks and Retirement/Death Benefits

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports enhanced disclosure and shareholder oversight of executive benefits and other in-kind retirement perquisites. For example, compensation devices like executive pensions (SERPs), deferred compensation plans, below-market-rate loans or guaranteed post-retirement consulting fees can amount to significant liabilities to shareholders and it is often difficult for investors to find adequate disclosure of their full terms. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes any perquisite or benefit to executives that exceeds what is generally offered to other company employees. From a shareholder prospective, the cost of these executive entitlements would be better allocated to performance-based forms of executive compensation during their term in office.

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting to put extraordinary benefits contained in SERP agreements to a shareholder vote unless the company’s executive pension plans do not contain excessive benefits beyond what is offered under employee-wide plans.

 

B-170


Table of Contents

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling companies to adopt a policy of discontinuing or obtaining shareholder approval for any future agreements and corporate policies that could oblige the company to make payments or awards following the death of a senior executive in the form of unearned salary or bonuses, accelerated vesting or the continuation in force of unvested equity grants, perquisites and other payments or awards made in lieu of compensation. This would not apply to any benefit programs or equity plan proposals that the broad-based employee population is eligible.

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

An Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) is an employee benefit plan that makes the employees of a company also owners of stock in that company. Recent academic research of the performance of ESOPs in closely held companies found that ESOPs appear to increase overall sales, employment, and sales per employee over what would have been expected absent an ESOP. Studies have also found that companies with an ESOP are also more likely to still be in business several years later, and are more likely to have other retirement oriented benefit plans than comparable non-ESOP companies.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that request shareholder approval in order to implement an ESOP or to increase authorized shares for existing ESOPs except in cases when the number of shares allocated to the ESOP is deemed excessive (i.e. generally greater than five percent of outstanding shares).

OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals

 

   

Vote FOR amendments that place a cap on annual grants or amend administrative features;

 

   

Vote FOR plans that simply amend shareholder-approved plans to include administrative features or place a cap on the annual grants that any one participant may receive in order to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) of OBRA.

Amendments to Add Performance-Based Goals

Section 162(m) of the IRS Code Section limits the deductibility of compensation in excess of $1 million to a named executive officer unless certain prescribed actions are taken including shareholder approval and the establishment of performance goals.

 

   

Vote FOR amendments to add performance goals to existing compensation plans to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) of OBRA, unless they are inappropriate.

Amendments to Increase Shares and Retain Tax Deductions Under OBRA

Amendments to existing plans to increase shares reserved and to qualify the plan for favorable tax treatment under the provisions of Section 162(m) should be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Approval of Cash or Cash-and-Stock Bonus Plans

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST cash or cash-and-stock bonus plans to exempt the compensation from taxes under the provisions of Section 162(m) of OBRA if the plan provides for awards to individual participants in excess of $2 million a year;

 

   

Vote AGAINST plans that are deemed to be excessive because they are not justified by performance measures;

 

   

Vote AGAINST plans if the compensation committee does not fully consist of independent outsiders, as defined by Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ definition of director independence.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-171


Table of Contents

 

AUDITORS

Auditors play an integral role in certifying the integrity and reliability of corporate financial statements on which investors rely to gauge the financial well being of a company and the viability of an investment. The well-documented auditor-facilitated bankruptcies and scandals at several large public companies in recent years underscore the catastrophic consequences that investors can suffer when the audit process breaks down.

Auditor Independence

The recent wave of accounting scandals at companies illuminate the need to ensure auditor independence in the face of selling consulting services to audit clients. At the large four accounting firms, revenues from non-audit services grew from 13% of total revenues in 1981 to half of total revenue in 2000. A study of over 1,200 US companies in the S&P 500, Mid Cap, and Small Cap indices found that 72% of fees paid to auditors in 2002 were for non-audit services, exactly the same level as 2001. We believe that this ratio should be reversed and that non-audit fees should make up no more than one-quarter of all fees paid to the auditor so as to properly discourage even the appearance of any undue influence upon an auditor’s objectivity.

Under SEC rules, disclosed categories of professional fees paid for audit and non-audit services are as follows: (1) Audit Fees, (2) Audit-Related Fees, (3) Tax Fees, and (4) All Other Fees. Under the revised reporting requirements, a company will also be required to describe — in qualitative terms — the types of services provided under the three categories other than Audit Fees. The following fee categories are defined as: A) tax compliance or preparation fees are excluded from our calculations of non-audit fees; and B) fees for consulting services for tax-avoidance strategies and tax shelters will be included in “other fees” and will be considered non-audit fees if the proxy disclosure does not indicate the nature of the tax services. In circumstances where “Other” fees include fees related to significant one-time capital structure events: initial public offerings, bankruptcy emergence, and spin-offs; and the company makes public disclosure of the amount and nature of those fees which are an exception to the standard “non-audit fee” category, then such fees may be excluded from the non-audit fees considered in determining the ratio of non-audit to audit/audit-related fees/tax compliance and preparation for purposes of determining whether non-audit fees are excessive.

As auditors are the backbone upon which a company’s financial health is measured, auditor independence is absolutely essential for rendering objective opinions upon which investors then rely. When an auditor is paid excessive consulting fees in addition to fees paid for auditing, the company-auditor relationship is left open to conflicts of interest.

Auditor Ratification

The ratification of auditors is an important component of good governance. In light of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and increased shareholder scrutiny, some companies are opting to take auditor ratification off the ballot. Neglecting to include the ratification of auditors on the proxy takes away the fundamental shareholder tight to ratify the company’s choice of auditor. Whereas shareholder ratification of auditors was once considered routine by many shareowners, the subsequent accounting scandals have caused shareholders to be more vigilant about the integrity of the auditors certifying their companies’ financial statements. It is now viewed as best practice for companies to place the item on ballot.

Although U.S. companies are not legally required to allow shareholders to ratify their appointment of independent auditors, roughly 60% of S&P 500 companies allow for shareholder ratification of their auditors. Submission of the audit firm for approval at the annual meeting on an annual basis gives shareholders the means to weigh in on their satisfaction (or lack thereof) on the auditor’s independent execution of their duties.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services firmly believes mandatory auditor ratification is in line with sound and transparent corporate governance and remains an important mechanism to ensure the integrity of the auditor’s

 

B-172


Table of Contents

work. In the absence of legislation mandating shareholder ratification of auditors, the failure by a company to present its selection of auditors for shareholder ratification should be discouraged as it undermines good governance and disenfranchises shareholders.

Proposals to ratify auditors is examined for potential conflicts of interest, with particular attention to the fees paid to the auditor, as well as whether the ratification of auditors has been put up for shareholder vote.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to ratify auditors when the amount of audit fees is equal to or greater than three times (75 percent) the amount paid for consulting, unless: i) An auditor has a financial interest in or association with the company, and is therefore not independent; or ii) There is reason to believe that the independent auditor has rendered an opinion which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to ratify auditors when the amount of non-audit consulting fees exceeds a quarter of all fees paid to the auditor;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking to limit companies from buying consulting services from their auditor.

Auditor Rotation

Long-term relationships between auditors and their clients can impede auditor independence, objectivity and professional skepticism. Such long-standing relationships foster an undesirable coziness between audit firms and their clients, which can cause the auditors to lose their independence and become less questioning especially where lucrative contracts for the provision of non-audit consulting services are involved. Mandatory auditor rotation is a widely supported safeguard against improper audits and is viewed by many as an effective mechanism for mitigating the potential risks borne by long-term auditor-client relationships.

Proponents of compulsory audit firm rotation contend that rotation policies promote objectivity and independence among auditors and minimize the scope of vested interests developing in the audit. Opponents of audit firm rotation argue that regular re-tendering is a costly practice, likely to reduce audit quality and increase the risk of audit failure in the early years due to the time required to gain cumulative knowledge of an often complex and geographically diverse business. A solution around this apparent negative effect of mandatory rotation is to keep a longer rotation period.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recommends that companies not maintain the same audit firm in excess of seven years, and will consider voting against auditors if their tenure at a company exceeds seven years. A revolving seven-year rotation period allows the auditor to develop cumulative knowledge of a company’s business and the effect of changes in the business along with the corresponding changes in its risks, thereby enhancing the quality of the audit and trammeling potential loss of auditor objectivity and independence. Many institutional investors argue that the increased costs associated with compulsory auditor rotation are a lesser evil vis-à-vis the larger evil of the costs to shareholders when the objectionable coziness between clients and long-standing auditors leads to gross erosion of shareholder value.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals to ensure auditor independence through measures such as mandatory auditor rotation (no less than every seven years).

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

Indemnification clauses allow auditors to avoid liability for potential damages, including punitive damages. Eliminating concerns about being sued for carelessness could lead to; 1) potential impairment of external auditor independence and impartiality by contractual clauses limiting their liability; and 2) a decrease the quality and reliability of the audit given the lack of consequence for an inadequate audit.

 

B-173


Table of Contents

 

Given the substantial settlements against auditors in recent years for poor audit practices and the cost of such insurance to the company and its shareholders, there are legitimate concerns over the broader use of indemnification clauses. Such agreements may weaken the objectivity, impartiality and performance of audit firms. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes it is important for shareholders to understand the full risks and implications of these agreements and determine what impact they could have on shareholder value. At the present time, however, due to poor disclosure in this area, it is difficult to identify the existence and extent of limited liability provisions and auditor agreements, and investors lack the information needed to make informed decisions regarding these agreements.

Without uniform disclosure, it is difficult to consistently apply policy and make informed vote recommendations. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews the use of indemnification clauses and limited liability provisions in auditor agreements on a case-by-case basis, when disclosure is present.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from Audit Committee members if there is persuasive evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.

Disclosures Under Section 404 of Sarbanes-Oxley Act

Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires that companies document and assess the effectiveness of their internal financial controls. Beginning in 2005, most public companies must obtain annual attestation of the effectiveness of their internal controls over financial reporting from their outside auditors. Companies with significant material weaknesses identified in the Section 404 disclosures potentially have ineffective internal financial reporting controls, which may lead to inaccurate financial statements, hampering shareholders’ ability to make informed investment decisions, and may lead to destruction of public confidence and shareholder value. The Audit Committee is ultimately responsible for the integrity and reliability of the company’s financial information and its system of internal controls.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from Audit Committee members under certain circumstances when a material weakness rises to a level of serious concern, if there are chronic internal control issues, or if there is an absence of established effective control mechanisms;

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals to ratify auditors if there is reason to believe that the independent auditor has rendered an opinion which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

Adverse Opinions

An Adverse Opinion on the company’s financial statements is issued when the auditor determines that the financial statements are materially misstated and, when considered as a whole, do not conform to GAAP. It essentially states that the information contained is materially incorrect, unreliable, and inaccurate in order to assess the company’s financial position and results of operations.

Adverse opinions on companies’ financial statements are generally very rare because they essentially state that a significant portion of the financial statements are unreliable and the auditor had no choice but to issue an adverse opinion after a long process of seeking resolution with the company subjected to the audit.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from Audit Committee members if the company receives an Adverse Opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditors.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-174


Table of Contents

 

TAKEOVER DEFENSES

Poison Pills

Shareholder rights plans, typically known as poison pills, take the form of rights or warrants issued to shareholders and are triggered when a potential acquiring stockholder reaches a certain threshold of ownership. When triggered, poison pills generally allow shareholders to purchase shares from, or sell shares back to, the target company (“flip-in-pill”) and/or the potential acquirer (“flip-out-pill”) at a price far out of line with fair market value.

Depending on the type of pill, the triggering event can either transfer wealth from the target company or dilute the equity holdings of current shareholders. Poison pills insulate management from the threat of a change in control and provide the target board with veto power over takeover bids. Because poison pills greatly alter the balance of power between shareholders and management, shareholders should be allowed to make their own evaluation of such plans.

In evaluating management proposals on poison pills, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services consider the company’s rationale for adopting the pill and its existing governance structure in determining whether or not the pill appropriately serves in shareholders’ best interests. The rationale for adopting the pill should be thoroughly explained by the company. Additionally, we examine the company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, or any problematic governance concerns.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis shareholder proposals to redeem a company’s poison pill;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis management proposals to ratify a poison pill;

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from any board where a dead-hand poison pill provision is in place. From a shareholder perspective, there is no justification for a dead-hand provision. Directors of companies with these lethal protective devices should be held fully accountable.

Net operating losses (NOL) pills, which are used to preserve a tax benefit (as opposed to traditional poison pills which are used as a takeover defense), typically have low triggers that some shareholders have difficulty supporting. This lack of support may have the effect of discouraging issuers from seeking shareholder approval for such pills. In assessing NOL pills, we take into account the unique purpose and features of NOL pills to enable shareholders make informed decisions when presented with proposals to adopt such pills, and to encourage issuers to submit such pills to a shareholder vote.

For management proposals to adopt a poison pill for the stated purpose of preserving a company’s net operating losses (“NOL pills”), the following factors are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE following basis:

 

   

The ownership threshold to transfer (NOL pills generally have a trigger slightly below 5%);

 

   

The value of the NOLs;

 

   

The term;

 

   

Shareholder protection mechanisms (sunset provision, or commitment to cause expiration of the pill upon exhaustion or expiration of NOLs);

 

   

The company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, track record of responsiveness to shareholders, and any other problematic governance concerns; and

 

   

Any other factors that may be applicable.

 

B-175


Table of Contents

 

Greenmail

Greenmail payments are targeted share repurchases by management of company stock from individuals or groups seeking control of the company. Since only the hostile party receives payment, usually at a substantial premium over the market value of shares, the practice discriminates against most shareholders. This transferred cash, absent the greenmail payment, could be put to much better use for reinvestment in the company, payment of dividends, or to fund a public share repurchase program.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to adopt an anti-greenmail provision in their charter or bylaws that would thereby restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments to certain shareholders;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all anti-greenmail proposals when they are presented as bundled items with other charter or bylaw amendments.

Shareholder Ability to Remove Directors

Shareholder ability to remove directors, with or without cause, is either prescribed by a state’s business corporation law, individual company’s articles of incorporation, or its corporate bylaws. Many companies have sought shareholder approval for charter or bylaw amendments that would prohibit the removal of directors except for cause, thus ensuring that directors would retain their directorship for their full-term unless found guilty of self-dealing. By requiring cause to be demonstrated through due process, management insulates the directors from removal even if a director has been performing poorly, not attending meetings, or not acting in the best interests of shareholders.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals which seek to restore the authority of shareholders to remove directors with or without cause;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

Shareholder Ability to Alter the Size of the Board

Proposals that would allow management to increase or decrease the size of the board at its own discretion are often used by companies as a takeover defense. Proposals to fix the size of the board at a specific number can prevent management from increasing the board size without shareholder approval when facing a proxy context. By increasing the size of the board, management can make it more difficult for dissidents to gain control of the board. Fixing the size of the board also prevents a reduction in the size of the board as a strategy to oust independent directors. Fixing board size also prevents management from increasing the number of directors in order to dilute the effects of cumulative voting.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that seek to fix the size of the board within an acceptable range;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board without shareholder approval.

SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS

Confidential Voting

The confidential ballot ensures that voters are not subject to real or perceived coercion. In an open voting system, management can determine who has voted against its nominees or proposals before a final vote count. As a result, shareholders can be pressured to vote with management at companies with which they maintain or would like to establish a business relationship.

 

B-176


Table of Contents

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that request corporations to adopt confidential voting, the use of independent tabulators, and the use of independent inspectors for an election as long as the proposals include clauses for proxy contests. In the case of a contested election, management is permitted to request that the dissident group honor its confidential voting policy. If the dissidents agree, the policy remains in place. If the dissidents do not agree, the confidential voting policy is waived;

 

   

Vote FOR management proposals to adopt confidential voting procedures.

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

Most state corporation statutes allow shareholders to call a special meeting when they want to take action on certain matters that arise between regularly scheduled annual meetings. Sometimes this right applies only if a shareholder or a group of shareholders own a specified percentage of shares, with ten percent being the most common. Shareholders may lose the ability to remove directors, initiate a shareholder resolution, or respond to a beneficial offer without having to wait for the next scheduled meeting if they are unable to act at a special meeting of their own calling.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to call special meetings;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that remove restrictions on the right of shareholders to act independently of management;

 

   

Vote AGAINST provisions that would require advance notice of more than sixty days.

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

Consent solicitations allow shareholders to vote on and respond to shareholder and management proposals by mail without having to act at a physical meeting. A consent card is sent by mail for shareholder approval and only requires a signature for action. Some corporate bylaws require supermajority votes for consents, while at others standard annual meeting rules apply. Shareholders may lose the ability to remove directors, initiate a shareholder resolution, or respond to a beneficial offer without having to wait for the next scheduled meeting if they are unable to act at a special meeting of their own calling.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to take action by written consent;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to allow or make easier shareholder action by written consent.

Unequal Voting Rights

Incumbent managers are able to use unequal voting rights through the creation of a separate class of shares that has superior voting rights to the common shares of regular shareholders. This separate class of shares with disproportionate voting power allows management to concentrate its power and insulate itself from the wishes of the majority of shareholders. Dual class exchange offers involve a transfer of voting rights from one group of shareholders to another group of shareholders typically through the payment of a preferential dividend. A dual class recapitalization plan also establishes two classes of common stock with unequal voting rights, but initially involves an equal distribution of preferential and inferior voting shares to current shareholders.

 

   

Vote FOR resolutions that seek to maintain or convert to a one-share-one-vote capital structure;

 

   

Vote AGAINST requests for the creation or continuation of dual class capital structures or the creation of new or additional super-voting shares.

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Amend the Charter or Bylaws

Supermajority shareholder vote requirements for charter or bylaw amendments are often the result of “lock-in” votes, which are the votes required to repeal new provisions to the corporate charter. Supermajority

 

B-177


Table of Contents

provisions violate the principle that a simple majority of voting shares should be all that is necessary to effect change regarding a company and its corporate governance provisions. Requiring more than this may entrench managers by blocking actions that are in the best interests of shareholders.

The general lack of credit availability for financially distressed companies has resulted in “rescue” or highly dilutive stock and warrant issuances, which often comprise a majority of the company’s voting stock upon conversion. When an investor takes control of the company through the conversion of securities, the new owners often seek statutory amendments, such as adopting written consent, or allowing 50 percent shareholders to call a special meeting, that allow effective control over the company with little or no input from minority shareholders.

In such cases, the existing supermajority vote requirements would serve to protect minority shareholders’ interests. The reduction in the vote requirements, when coupled with low quorum requirements (in Nevada and other states) could shift the balance in power away from small shareholders while overly empowering large shareholders.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve charter and bylaw amendments;

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals seeking to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements when they accompany management sponsored proposals to also change certain charter or bylaw amendments;

 

   

Vote FOR management or shareholder proposals to reduce supermajority vote requirements for charter and bylaw amendments. However, for companies with shareholder(s) who have significant ownership levels, vote CASE-BY-CASE, taking into account i) ownership structure, ii) quorum requirements, and iii) supermajority vote requirements.

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Approve Mergers

Supermajority provisions violate the principle that a simple majority of voting shares should be all that is necessary to effect change regarding a company and its corporate governance provisions. Requiring more than this may entrench managers by blocking actions that are in the best interests of shareholders.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve mergers and other significant business combinations;

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements for mergers and other significant business combinations.

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals to reimburse for proxy solicitation expenses;

 

   

When voting in conjunction with support of a dissident slate, always support the reimbursement of all appropriate proxy solicitation expenses associated with the election;

 

   

Generally support requests seeking to reimburse a shareholder proponent for all reasonable campaign expenditures for a proposal approved by the majority of shareholders.

Bundled Proposals

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on bundled or conditional proxy proposals. In the case of items that are conditioned upon each other, examine the benefits and costs of the packaged items. In instances when the joint effect of the conditioned items is not in shareholders’ best interests, vote AGAINST the proposals. If the combined effect is positive, support such proposals.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-178


Table of Contents

 

MERGERS & ACQUISITIONS/CORPORATE RESTRUCTURINGS

A number of academic and industry studies in recent years have estimated that nearly three quarters of all corporate acquisitions fail to create economically meaningful shareholder value. These studies have also demonstrated that the larger the deal the greater the risk in realizing long-term value for shareholders of the acquiring firm. These risks include integration challenges, over-estimation of expected synergies, incompatible corporate cultures and poor succession planning. Indeed, some studies have found that smaller deals within specialized industries on average outperform “big bet” larger deals by a statistically significant factor.

In analyzing M&A deals, private placements or other transactional related items on proxy, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services performs a well-rounded analysis that seeks to balance all facets of the deal to ascertain whether the proposed acquisition is truly going to generate long-term value for shareholders and enhance the prospects of the ongoing corporation.

Votes on mergers and acquisitions are always considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Impact of the merger on shareholder value;

 

   

Perspective of ownership (target vs. acquirer) in the deal;

 

   

Form and mix of payment (i.e. stock, cash, debt, etc.);

 

   

Fundamental value drivers behind the deal;

 

   

Anticipated financial and operating benefits realizable through combined synergies;

 

   

Offer price (cost vs. premium);

 

   

Change-in-control payments to executive officers;

 

   

Financial viability of the combined companies as a single entity;

 

   

Was the deal put together in good faith? What kind of auction setting took place? Were negotiations carried out at arm’s length? Was any portion of the process tainted by possible conflicts of interest?;

 

   

Fairness opinion (or lack thereof);

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights;

 

   

What are the potential legal or environmental liability risks associated with the target firm?;

 

   

Impact on community stakeholders and employees in both workforces;

 

   

How will the merger adversely affect employee benefits like pensions and health care?

Fair Price Provisions

Fair price provisions were originally designed to specifically defend against the most coercive of takeover devises- the two-tiered, front-end loaded tender offer. In such a hostile takeover, the bidder offers cash for enough shares to gain control of the target. At the same time, the acquirer states that once control has been obtained, the target’s remaining shares will be purchased with cash, cash and securities, or only securities. Since the payment offered for the remaining stock is, by design, less valuable than the original offer for the controlling shares, shareholders are forced to sell out early to maximize the value of their shares. Standard fair price provisions require that in the absence of board or shareholder approval of the acquisition the bidder must pay the remaining shareholders the same price for their shares that brought control.

 

   

Vote FOR fair price proposals as long as the shareholder vote requirement embedded in the provision is no more than a majority of disinterested shares;

 

B-179


Table of Contents

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to lower the shareholder vote requirement in existing fair price provisions.

Corporate Restructuring

 

   

Votes concerning corporate restructuring proposals, including minority squeeze outs, leveraged buyouts, spin-offs, liquidations, and asset sales, are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Appraisal Rights

Rights of appraisal provide shareholders who do not approve of the terms of certain corporate transactions the right to demand a judicial review in order to determine the fair value for their shares. The right of appraisal applies to mergers, sale of corporate assets, and charter amendments that may have a materially adverse effect on the rights of dissenting shareholders.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to restore or provide shareholders with the right of appraisal.

Spin-offs

 

   

Votes on spin-offs are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis depending on the tax and regulatory advantages, planned use of sale proceeds, market focus, and managerial incentives.

Asset Sales

 

   

Votes on asset sales are made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis after considering the impact on the balance sheet/working capital, value received for the asset, and potential elimination of diseconomies.

Liquidations

 

   

Votes on liquidations are made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis after reviewing management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives, appraisal value of assets, and the compensation plan for executives managing the liquidation.

Going Private Transactions (LBOs, Minority Squeezeouts)

 

   

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on going private transactions, taking into account the following: offer price/premium, fairness opinion, how the deal was negotiated, conflicts of interest, other alternatives/offers considered, and non-completion risk.

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on “going dark” transactions, determining whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by taking into consideration whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly-traded (examination of trading volume, liquidity, and market research of the stock), cash-out value, whether the interests of continuing and cashed-out shareholders are balanced, and market reaction to public announcement of transaction.

Changing Corporate Name

 

   

Vote FOR changing the corporate name in all instances if proposed and supported by management and the board.

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

The recent financial crisis has placed Chapter 11 bankruptcy reorganizations as a potential alternative for distressed companies. While the number of bankruptcies has risen over the past year as evidenced by many firms,

 

B-180


Table of Contents

including General Motors and Lehman Brothers, the prevalence of these reorganizations can vary year over year due to, among other things, market conditions and a company’s ability to sustain its operations. Additionally, the amount of time that lapses between a particular company’s entrance into Chapter 11 and its submission of a plan of reorganization varies significantly depending on the complexity, timing, and jurisdiction of the particular case. These plans are often put to a vote of shareholders (in addition to other interested parties), as required by the Bankruptcy Code.

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE basis on proposals to common shareholders on bankruptcy plans of reorganization, considering the following factors including, but not limited to:

 

   

Estimated value and financial prospects of the reorganized company;

 

   

Percentage ownership of current shareholders in the reorganized company;

 

   

Whether shareholders are adequately represented in the reorganization process (particularly through the existence of an Official Equity Committee);

 

   

The cause(s) of the bankruptcy filing, and the extent to which the plan of reorganization addresses the cause(s); Existence of a superior alternative to the plan of reorganization; and Governance of the reorganized company.

 

B-181


Table of Contents

 

CAPITAL STRUCTURE

The management of a corporation’s capital structure involves a number of important issues including dividend policy, types of assets, opportunities for growth, ability to finance new projects internally, and the cost of obtaining additional capital. Many financing decisions have a significant impact on shareholder value, particularly when they involve the issuance of additional common stock, preferred stock, or debt.

Common Stock Authorization

State statutes and stock exchanges require shareholder approval for increases in the number of common shares. Corporations increase their supply of common stock for a variety of ordinary business purposes: raising new capital, funding stock compensation programs, business acquisitions, implementation of stock splits, or payment of stock dividends.

Clear justification should accompany all management requests for shareholders approval of increases in authorized common stock. We support increases in authorized common stock to fund stock splits that are in shareholders’ interests. Consideration will be made on a case-by-case basis on proposals when the company intends to use the additional stock to implement a poison pill or other takeover defense. The amount of additional stock requested in comparison to the requests of the company’s peers as well as the company’s articulated reason for the increase must be evaluated.

 

   

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to increase the number of shares of common stock authorized for issue. The following factors will be considered:

 

   

Past Board Performance: i) the company’s use of authorized shares during the last three years; ii) one- and three-year total shareholder return; and practices iii) the board’s governance structure and practices including existing takeover defenses and presence of egregious equity compensation practices;

 

   

The Current Request: i) specific reasons/rationale for the proposed increase; ii) the dilutive impact of the request; and iii) risks to shareholders of not approving the request.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals at companies with dual-class capital structures to increase the number of authorized shares of the class of stock that has superior voting rights;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposed common stock authorizations that increase the existing authorization by more than fifty percent unless a clear need for the excess shares is presented by the company.

Reverse Stock Splits

Reverse splits exchange multiple shares for a lesser amount to increase share price. Increasing share price is sometimes necessary to restore a company’s share price to a level that will allow it to be traded on the national stock exchanges. In addition, some brokerage houses have a policy of not monitoring or investing in very low priced shares. Reverse stock splits can help maintain stock liquidity.

Management proposals to implement a reverse stock split will be reviewed on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into account whether there is a corresponding proportional decrease in authorized shares. Generally support a reverse stock split if management provides a reasonable justification for the split and reduces authorized shares accordingly. Without a corresponding decrease, a reverse stock split is effectively an increase in authorized shares by reducing the number of shares outstanding while leaving the number of authorized shares to be issued at the pre-split level.

Blank Check Preferred Authorization

Preferred stock is an equity security which has certain features similar to debt instruments- such as fixed dividend payments and seniority of claims to common stock — and usually carries little to no voting rights. The

 

B-182


Table of Contents

terms of blank check preferred stock give the board of directors the power to issue shares of preferred stock at their discretion with voting, conversion, distribution, and other rights to be determined by the board at time of issue. Blank check preferred stock can be used for sound corporate purposes but can also be used as a device to thwart hostile takeovers without shareholder approval.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to create “declawed” blank check preferred stock (stock that cannot be used as a takeover defense);

 

   

Vote FOR requests to require shareholder approval for blank check authorizations;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to authorize preferred stock in cases where the company specifies the voting, dividend, conversion, and other rights of such stock and the terms of the preferred stock appear reasonable;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that would authorize the creation of new classes of preferred stock with unspecified voting, conversion, dividend, distribution, and other rights (“blank check” preferred stock);

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to increase the number of blank check preferred stock authorized for issuance when no shares have been issued or reserved for a specific purpose.

Adjust Par Value of Common Stock

Stock that has a fixed per share value that is on its certificate is called par value stock. The purpose of par value stock is to establish the maximum responsibility of a stockholder in the event that a corporation becomes insolvent. Proposals to reduce par value come from certain state level requirements for regulatory industries such as banks and other legal requirements relating to the payment of dividends.

 

   

Vote FOR management proposals to reduce the par value of common stock.

Preemptive Rights

Preemptive rights permit shareholders to share proportionately in any new issues of stock of the same class. These rights guarantee existing shareholders the first opportunity to purchase shares of new issues of stock in the same class as their own and in the same proportion. The absence of these rights could cause stockholders’ interest in a company to be reduced by the sale of additional shares without their knowledge and at prices unfavorable to them. Preemptive rights, however, can make it difficult for corporations to issue large blocks of stock for general corporate purposes. Both corporations and shareholders benefit when corporations are able to arrange issues without preemptive rights that do not result in a substantial transfer of control.

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to create or abolish preemptive rights. In evaluating proposals on preemptive rights, we look at the size of a company and the characteristics of its shareholder base.

Debt Restructuring

We review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to increase common and/or preferred shares and to issue shares as part of a debt-restructuring plan. The following factors are considered:

 

   

Dilution — How much will the ownership interest of existing shareholders be reduced, and how extreme will dilution to any future earnings be?

 

   

Change in Control — Will the transaction result in a change in control of the company? Are board and committee seats guaranteed? Do standstill provisions and voting agreements exist?

 

   

Financial Issues — company’s financial situation, degree of need for capital, use of proceeds, and effect of the financing on the company’s cost of capital

 

B-183


Table of Contents

 

   

Terms of the offer — discount/premium in purchase price to investor including any fairness opinion,

 

   

termination penalties and exit strategy

 

   

Conflict of interest — arm’s length transactions and managerial incentives

 

   

Management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals regarding debt restructurings.

Vote FOR the debt restructuring if it is expected that the company will file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-184


Table of Contents

 

STATE OF INCORPORATION

Voting on State Takeover Statutes

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to opt in or out of state takeover statutes (including control share acquisition statutes, control share cash-out statutes, freeze out provisions, fair price provisions, stakeholder laws, poison pill endorsements, severance pay and labor contract provisions, anti-greenmail provisions, and disgorgement provisions). We generally support opting into stakeholder protection statutes if they provide comprehensive protections for employees and community stakeholders. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is less supportive of takeover statutes that only serve to protect incumbent management from accountability to shareholders and which negatively influence shareholder value.

Reincorporations Proposals

Management or shareholder proposals to change a company’s state of incorporation should be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, giving consideration to both financial and corporate governance concerns including the following:

 

   

Reasons for reincorporation;

 

   

Comparison of company’s governance practices and provisions prior to and following the reincorporation; and

 

   

Comparison of corporation laws of original state and destination state

Vote FOR reincorporation when the economic factors outweigh any neutral or negative governance changes.

Offshore Reincorporations and Tax Havens

For a company that seeks to reincorporate, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services evaluates the merits of the move on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into consideration the company’s strategic rationale for the move, the potential economic ramifications, potential tax benefits, and any corporate governance changes that may impact shareholders. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes there are a number of concerns associated with a company looking to reincorporate from the United States to offshore locales such as Bermuda, the Cayman Islands or Panama. The trend of U.S. companies seeking to move offshore appears to be on the rise, and shareholders are just beginning to understand the web of complexities surrounding the legal, tax, and governance implications involved in such a transaction.

When reviewing a proposed offshore move, the following factors are considered:

 

   

Legal recourse for U.S. stockholders of the new company and the enforcement of legal judgments against the company under the U.S. securities laws;

 

   

The transparency (or lack thereof) of the new locale’s legal system;

 

   

Adoption of any shareholder-unfriendly corporate law provisions;

 

   

Actual, quantifiable tax benefits associated with foreign incorporation;

 

   

Potential for accounting manipulations and/or discrepancies;

 

   

Any pending U.S. legislation concerning offshore companies;

 

   

Prospects of reputational harm and potential damage to brand name via increased media coverage concerning corporate expatriation.

Furthermore, generally support shareholder requests calling for “expatriate” companies that are domiciled abroad yet predominantly owned and operated in America to re-domesticate back to a U.S. state jurisdiction.

 

B-185


Table of Contents

 

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY & ACCOUNTABILITY

Social, Environmental and Sustainability Issues

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports social, workforce, and environmental shareholder-sponsored resolutions if they seek to create responsible corporate citizens while at the same time attempting to enhance long-term shareholder value. We typically support proposals that ask for disclosure reporting of information that is not available outside the company that is not proprietary in nature. Such reporting is particularly most vital when it appears that a company has not adequately addressed shareholder concerns regarding social, workplace, environmental and/or other issues. A determination whether the request is relevant to the company’s core business and in-line with industry practice will be made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. The proponent of the resolution must make the case that the benefits of additional disclosure outweigh the costs of producing the report.

In determining our vote on social, workplace, environmental, and other related proposals, we specifically analyze the following factors:

 

   

Whether adoption of the proposal would have either a positive or negative impact on the company’s short-term or long-term share value;

 

   

Percentage of sales, assets, and earnings affected;

 

   

Degree to which the company’s stated position on the issues could affect its reputation or sales, or leave it vulnerable to boycott or selective purchasing;

 

   

Whether the issues presented should be dealt with through government or company-specific action;

 

   

Whether the company has already responded in some appropriate manner to the request embodied in a proposal;

 

   

Whether the company’s analysis and voting recommendation to shareholders is persuasive;

 

   

What its industry peers have done in response to the issue;

 

   

Whether the proposal itself is well framed and reasonable;

 

   

Whether implementation of the proposal would achieve the objectives sought in the proposal;

 

   

Whether the subject of the proposal is best left to the discretion of the board.

In general, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that request the company to furnish information helpful to shareholders in evaluating the company’s operations from top to bottom. In order to be able to intelligently monitor their investments, shareholders often need information that is best provided by the company in which they have invested on behalf of their end beneficiaries. Qualified requests satisfying the aforementioned criteria usually merit support.

Proposals requesting that the company cease certain actions that the proponent believes are harmful to society or some segment of society will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Special attention will be made to the company’s legal and ethical obligations, its ability to remain profitable, and potential negative publicity if the company fails to honor the request. A high standard will need to be met by proponents requesting specific action like divesture of a business line or operation, legal remuneration, or withdrawal from certain high-risk markets.

 

B-186


Table of Contents

 

I. GENERAL CSR RELATED

Special Policy Review and Shareholder Advisory Committees

These resolutions propose the establishment of special committees of the board to address broad corporate policy and provide forums for ongoing dialogue on issues including, but not limited to: shareholder relations, the environment, occupational health and safety, and executive compensation.

 

   

Support these proposals when they appear to offer a potentially effective method for enhancing shareholder value.

Operations in Protected or Sensitive Areas

Operating in regions protected or established under national or international categorization guidelines, including wildlife refuges, national forests, and IUCN categorized areas expose companies to increased oversight and the potential for associated risk and controversy. While it is important for a company to have the flexibility to operate in these regions to take advantage of strategic placement or growth, additional disclosure could be an important mitigating factor when addressing increased risk and oversight. Restrictions to the company’s operations, damaging public opinion, and costly litigation resulting from failure to comply with the requirements associated with protected or categorized regions could have a significant impact on shareholder value.

 

   

Generally support shareholder requests for reports outlining potential environmental damage from operations in protected regions, including wildlife refuges, unless the company does not currently have operations or plans to develop operations in these protected regions.

Land Use

Many large retail stores and real estate development firms have received criticism over their policies and processes for acquiring and developing land. Often, in such cases, there are organizations that support as well as those that oppose the proposed development.

Many of these requests brought forth by the respective stakeholders raise serious issues that can have a real impact on short-term shareholder value. However in some cases, additional reporting may be duplicative of existing disclosure or may fail to provide added benefit to shareholders commensurate with the associated cost or burden of providing additional information. Some of the companies targeted with this resolution have been subject to recent litigation and/or significant fines stemming from its land use practices or recent community boycotts.

 

   

Generally support shareholder resolutions that request better disclosure of detailed information on a company’s policies related to land use or development or compliance with local and national laws and zoning requirements.

International Financial Related

The rise of globalization has put increasing importance on the need for US companies to periodically monitor their business operations abroad. As a means to preserve brand integrity and protect against potentially costly litigation and negative public relations, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports shareholder proposals which call for a report on the company’s core business policies and procedures of its operations outside the United States.

Many of the resolutions which address a company’s international policies can include: impact of Foreign Direct Investment (FDI) in emerging market economies; corporate safeguards against money laundering; terrorist financing; economic de-stabilization concerns; relationships with international financial institutions (IFIs); and product sales/marketing abroad (i.e., tobacco, pharmaceutical drug pricing).

 

B-187


Table of Contents

 

   

Generally support proposals asking for policy clarification and reporting on foreign-related matters that can materially impact the company’s short and long-term bottom line.

Affirm Political Non-Partisanship

Employees should not be put in a position where professional standing and goodwill within the corporation could be jeopardized as a result of political beliefs. Responsible employment practices should protect workers from an environment characterized by political indoctrination or intimidation. Corporations should not devote resources to partisan political activities, nor should they compel their employees to contribute to or support particular causes. Moreover, it is wise for a corporation to maintain a politically neutral stance as to avoid potentially embarrassing conflicts of interests that could negatively impact the company’s brand name with consumers.

 

   

Generally support proposals affirming political non-partisanship within the company.

Political Contributions Reporting & Disclosure

Changes in legislation that governs corporate political giving have, rather than limiting such contributions, increased the complexity of tracking how much money corporations contribute to the political process and where that money ultimately ends up. A company’s involvement in the political process could impact shareholder value if such activities are not properly overseen and managed.

Shareholders have the right to know about corporate political activities, and management’s knowledge that such information can be made publicly available should encourage a company’s lawful and responsible use of political contributions.

Moreover, it is critical that shareholders understand the internal controls that are in place at a company to adequately manage political contributions. Given the significant reputational and financial risk involved in political giving, shareholders should expect management to have the necessary capabilities to monitor and track all monies distributed toward political groups and causes. These internal controls should be fully consistent with Section 404 requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

While political contributions, lobbying and other corporate political activity can benefit the strategic interests of a company, it is important that accountability mechanisms are in place to ensure that monies disbursed in support of political objectives actually generate identifiable returns on shareholder wealth. Such mechanisms serve to insure against the use of shareholder funds in the furtherance of narrow management agendas.

When analyzing the proposals, special consideration will be made if the target company has been the subject of significant controversy stemming from its contributions or political activities, if the company fails to disclose a policy to shareholders that outlines the process by which the company considers its political contributions, or if the company has recently been involved in significant controversy or litigation related to the company’s political contributions or governmental affairs.

 

   

Support reporting of political and political action committee (PAC) contributions;

 

   

Support establishment of corporate political contributions guidelines and internal reporting provisions or controls;

 

   

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals asking to publish in newspapers and public media the company’s political contributions as such publications could present significant cost to the company without providing commensurate value to shareholders.

 

B-188


Table of Contents

 

Military Sales

Shareholder proposals from church groups and other community organizations ask companies for detailed reports on foreign military sales. These proposals often can be created at reasonable cost to the company and contain no proprietary data. Large companies can supply this information without undue burden and provide shareholders with information affecting corporate performance and decision-making.

 

   

Generally support reports on foreign military sales and economic conversion of facilities and where such reporting will not disclose sensitive information that could impact the company adversely or increase its legal exposure;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking a company to develop specific military contracting criteria.

Report on Operations in Sensitive Regions or Countries

Over the past decade, a number of public companies — especially within the extractive sector — have withdrawn from geopolitically sensitive regions as a result of being associated with political controversies involving their host countries (i.e. Myanmar, the Sudan, China, Iran, etc.). Oil and natural gas companies, in particular, continue be the largest investors in many countries involved in human rights abuse and terrorist activities. As such, these companies become targets of consumer boycotts, public relations backlash and even governmental intervention.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals to adopt labor standards in connection with involvement in a certain market and other potentially sensitive geopolitical regions;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking a report on operations within a certain market and documentation of costs of continued involvement in a given country or region;

 

   

Generally support requests for establishment of a board committee to review and report on the reputational risks and legal compliance with U.S. sanctions as a result of the company’s continued operations in countries associated with terrorist sponsored activities;

 

   

Consider shareholder proposals to pull out of a certain market on a CASE-BY-CASE basis considering factors such as overall cost, FDI exposure, level of disclosure for investors, magnitude of controversy, and the current business focus of the company.

Recycling Policy

A number of companies have received proposals to step-up their recycling efforts, with the goal of reducing the company’s negative impact on the environment and reducing costs over the long-term.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that ask companies to increase their recycling efforts or to adopt a formal recycling policy.

II. CLIMATE CHANGE ~ GLOBAL WARMING

Shareholder proposals addressing environmental and energy concerns have been plentiful in recent years, and generally seek greater disclosure on an issue or seek to improve a company’s environmental practices in order to protect the world’s natural resources. In addition, some proponents cite the negative financial implications for companies with poor environmental practices, including liabilities associated with site clean-ups and lawsuits, as well as arguments that energy efficient products and clean environmental practices are sustainable business practices that will contribute to long-term shareholder value. Shareholders say the majority of independent atmospheric scientists agree that global warming poses a serious problem to the health and welfare of all countries, citing the findings of the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC), the world’s most authoritative scientific body on the subject. Shareholder proponents argue that companies can report on their greenhouse gas emissions within a few months at reasonable cost.

 

B-189


Table of Contents

 

Kyoto Compliance

The Kyoto Protocol was officially ratified in November 2004 and requires the reduction of greenhouse gas emissions by signatory countries in an effort to lower the global emissions of six key greenhouse gasses and address concerns over climate change. While some Kyoto signatory markets have not yet released the details of their respective regulations for companies, it is clear that there will be some significant financial impact on corporate issuers, especially those that operate in industries profoundly impacted by greenhouse gas emission constraints or regulation. In order to comply with the anticipated standards, companies will have to consider options such as: capital improvement to their facilities to reduce emissions, the cost of “trading” carbon credits on an open market to offset emission overages, or the expense of fines or restrictions resulting from noncompliance.

 

   

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports resolutions requesting that companies outline their preparations to comply with standards established by Kyoto Protocol signatory markets, unless: 1) The company does not maintain operations in Kyoto signatory markets; or 2) The company already evaluates and substantially discloses such information to shareholders; or, 3) Greenhouse gas emissions do not materially impact the company’s core businesses.

Greenhouse Gas Emissions

Scientists generally agree that gases released by chemical reactions including the burning of fossil fuels contribute to a “greenhouse effect” that traps the planet’s heat. Environmentalists claim that the greenhouse gases produced by the industrial age have caused recent weather crises such as heat waves, rainstorms, melting glaciers, rising sea levels and receding coastlines. With notable exceptions, business leaders have described the rise and fall of global temperatures as naturally occurring phenomena and depicted corporate impact on climate change as minimal.

Shareholder proposals asking a company to issue a report to shareholders — at reasonable cost and omitting proprietary information — on greenhouse gas emissions ask that the report include descriptions of efforts within companies to reduce emissions, their financial exposure and potential liability from operations that contribute to global warming, and their direct or indirect efforts to promote the view that global warming is not a threat. Proponents argue that there is scientific proof that the burning of fossil fuels causes global warming, that future legislation may make companies financially liable for their contributions to global warming, and that a report on the company’s role in global warming can be assembled at reasonable cost.

Investment in Renewable Energy

Filers of proposals on renewable energy ask companies to increase their investment in renewable energy sources and to work to develop products that rely more on renewable energy sources. Increased use of renewable energy will reduce the negative environmental impact of energy companies. In addition, as supplies of oil and coal exist in the earth in limited quantities, renewable energy sources represent a competitive, and some would even argue essential, long-term business strategy.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking increased investment in renewable energy sources, taking into account whether the terms of the resolution are realistic or overly restrictive for management to pursue.

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for a company to commit to reducing its greenhouse gas emissions under a reasonable timeline.

Sustainability Reporting and Planning

The concept of sustainability is commonly understood as meeting the needs of the present generation without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. Indeed, the term sustainability is

 

B-190


Table of Contents

complex and poses significant challenges for companies on many levels. Many in the investment community have termed this broader responsibility the “triple bottom line,” referring to the triad of performance goals related to economic prosperity, social responsibility and environmental quality. In essence, the concept requires companies to balance the needs and interests of their various stakeholders while operating in a manner that sustains business growth for the long-term, supports local communities and protects the environment and natural capital for future generations.

Reporting and enhanced disclosure addressing sustainable development is important to companies namely because it offers a formal structure for decision making that helps management teams anticipate and address important global trends that can have serious consequences for business and society. Shareholders may request general sustainability reports on a specific location (i.e. drilling in ANWR) or operation (i.e. nuclear facility), often requesting that the company detail the environmental, social, legal and other risks and/or potential liabilities of the specific project in question.

A number of companies have begun to report on sustainability issues using established standards in the marketplace. Such reporting focuses on corporate compliance and measurement regarding key economic, environmental, and social performance indicators. Many best practice companies release annual sustainability reports in conjunction to regular annual statement of operations.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking greater disclosure on the company’s environmental practices, and/or environmental risks and liabilities.

Endorsement of CERES Principles

These resolutions call for the adoption of principles that encourage the company to protect the environment and the safety and health of its employees. The CERES Principles, formulated by the Coalition of Environmentally Responsible Economies, require signing companies to address environmental issues, including protection of the biosphere, sustainable use of natural resources, reduction and disposal of wastes, energy conservation, and employee and community risk reduction. A signee to the CERES Principles would disclose its efforts in such areas through a standardized report submitted to CERES and made available to the public.

Evidence suggests that environmentally conscious companies may realize long-term savings by implementing programs to pollute less and conserve resources. In addition, environmentally responsible companies stand to benefit from good public relations and new marketing opportunities. Moreover, the reports that are required of signing companies provide shareholders with more information concerning topics they may deem relevant to their company’s financial well-being. Roughly thirty public companies have voluntarily adopted these principles.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that improve a company’s public image, reduce exposure to liabilities, and establish standards so that environmentally responsible companies and markets are not at a competitive financial disadvantage.

 

   

Vote FOR requests asking a company to formally adopt the CERES Principles;

 

   

Vote FOR adoption of reports to shareholders on environmental issues.

III. WORKPLACE PRACTICES  & HUMAN RIGHTS

Equal Employment Opportunity

These proposals generally request that a company establish a policy of reporting to shareholders its progress with equal opportunity and affirmative action programs. The costs of violating federal laws that prohibit discrimination by corporations are high and can affect corporate earnings.

 

B-191


Table of Contents

 

The Equal Opportunities Employment Commission (EEOC) does not release the company’s filings to the public unless it is involved in litigation, and it is difficult to obtain from other sources. Companies need to be very sensitive to minority employment issues as the new evolving work force becomes increasingly diverse. This information can be provided with little cost to the company and does not create an unreasonable burden on management.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals calling for action on equal employment opportunity and anti-discrimination;

 

   

Vote FOR legal and regulatory compliance and public reporting related to non-discrimination, affirmative action, workplace health and safety, environmental issues, and labor policies and practices that affect long-term corporate performance;

 

   

Vote FOR non-discrimination in salary, wages, and all benefits.

High-Performance Workplace

High-performance workplace practices emphasize employee training, participation, and feedback. The concept of a high-performance workplace has been endorsed by the U.S. Department of Labor and refers to a workplace that is designed to provide workers with the information, skills, incentives, and responsibility to make decisions essential for innovation, quality improvement and rapid response to changes in the marketplace. These standards embrace a “what is good for the worker is good for the company” philosophy. Studies have shown that improvement in human resources practices is associated with increases in total return to shareholders. High-performance workplace standards proposals can include linking compensation to social measures such as employee training, morale and safety, environmental performance and workplace lawsuits.

 

   

Generally support proposals that incorporate high-performance workplace standards.

Non-Discrimination in Retirement Benefits

A cash balance plan is a defined benefit plan that treats an earned retirement benefit as if it were a credit from a defined contribution plan, but which provides a stated benefit at the end of its term. Because employer contributions to these plans are credited evenly over the life of a plan and not based on a seniority formula, they may reduce payouts to long-term employees who are currently vested in plans.

Cash-balance pension conversions have undergone significant congressional and federal agency scrutiny in the wake of high-profile EEOC complaints on age discrimination and employee anger at several large blue-chip companies. While significant policy reform is unlikely in the short-term, business interests are worried enough that the National Association of Manufacturers and other pro-business lobbies have formed a coalition on Capitol Hill to preserve the essential features of the plans and to overturn a recent IRS ruling.

Driving the push behind conversions from traditional pension plans to cash-balance plans are the substantial savings that companies generate in the process. Critics point out that this savings is gained at the expense of the most senior employees. Shareholder resolutions call on corporate boards to establish a committee of outside directors to prepare a report to shareholders on the potential impact of pension-related proposals now being considered by national policymakers in reaction to the controversy spawned by the plans.

 

   

Support proposals calling for a non-discrimination policy with regard to retirement benefits and pension management at a company.

Fair Lending Reporting and Compliance

These resolutions call for financial institutions to comply with fair lending laws and statutes while avoiding predatory practices in their sub-prime lending. These predatory practices include: lending to borrowers with inadequate income, who will then default; not reporting on payment performances of borrowers to credit agencies; implying that credit life insurance is necessary to obtain the loan (packing); unnecessarily high fees;

 

B-192


Table of Contents

refinancing with high additional fees rather than working out a loan that is in arrears (flipping); and high pre-payment fees.

 

   

Support proposals calling for full compliance with fair-lending laws;

 

   

Support reporting on overall lending policies and data.

MacBride Principles

These resolutions call for the adoption of the MacBride Principles for operations located in Northern Ireland. They request companies operating abroad to support the equal employment opportunity policies that apply in facilities they operate domestically. The principles were established to address the sectarian hiring problems between Protestants and Catholics in Northern Ireland. It is well documented that Northern Ireland’s Catholic community faces much higher unemployment figures than the Protestant community. In response to this problem, the U.K. government instituted the New Fair Employment Act of 1989 (and subsequent amendments) to address the sectarian hiring problems.

Many companies believe that the Act adequately addresses the problems and that further action, including adoption of the MacBride Principles, only duplicates the efforts already underway. In evaluating a proposal to adopt the MacBride Principles, shareholders must decide whether the principles will cause companies to divest, and therefore worsen the unemployment problem, or whether the principles will promote equal hiring practices. Proponents believe that the Fair Employment Act does not sufficiently address the sectarian hiring problems. They argue that the MacBride Principles will stabilize the situation and promote further investment.

 

   

Support the MacBride Principles for operations in Northern Ireland that request companies to abide by equal employment opportunity policies.

Contract Supplier Standards

These resolutions call for compliance with governmental mandates and corporate policies regarding nondiscrimination, affirmative action, work place safety and health, and other basic labor protections.

We generally support proposals that:

 

   

Seek publication of a “Worker Code of Conduct” to be implemented by the company’s foreign suppliers and licensees, requiring they satisfy all applicable labor standards and laws protecting employees’ wages, benefits, working conditions, freedom of association, right to collectively bargain, and other rights;

 

   

Request a report summarizing the company’s current practices for enforcement of its Worker Code of Conduct;

 

   

Establishes independent monitoring mechanism in conjunction with local and respected religious and human rights groups to monitor supplier and licensee compliance with the Worker Code of Conduct;

 

   

Create incentives to encourage suppliers to raise standards rather than terminate contracts;

 

   

Implement policies for ongoing wage adjustments, ensuring adequate purchasing power and a sustainable living wage for employees of foreign suppliers and licensees;

 

   

Request public disclosure of contract supplier reviews on a regular basis;

 

   

Adopt labor standards for foreign and domestic suppliers to ensure that the company will not do business with foreign suppliers that manufacture products for sale in the U.S. using forced or child labor, or that fail to comply with applicable laws protecting employees’ wages and working conditions.

 

B-193


Table of Contents

 

Corporate Conduct and Labor Code of Conduct

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports proposals that call for the adoption and/or enforcement of clear principles or codes of conduct relating to countries in which there are systematic violations of human rights. These conditions include the use of slave, child, or prison labor, undemocratically elected governments, widespread reports by human rights advocates, fervent pro-democracy protests, or economic sanctions and boycotts.

Many proposals refer to the seven core conventions, commonly referred to as the “Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights At Work,” ratified by the International Labor Organization (ILO). The seven conventions fall under four broad categories: i) right to organize and bargain collectively; ii) non-discrimination in employment; iii) abolition of forced labor; and iv) end of child labor. Each of the 180 member nations of the ILO body are bound to respect and promote these rights to the best of their abilities.

 

   

Support the principles and codes of conduct relating to company investment and/or operations in countries with patterns of human rights abuses or pertaining to geographic regions experiencing political turmoil (Northern Ireland, Columbia, Burma, former Soviet Union, and China);

 

   

Support the implementation and reporting on ILO codes of conduct;

 

   

Support independent monitoring programs in conjunction with local and respected religious and human rights groups to monitor supplier and licensee compliance with Codes.

IV CONSUMER HEALTH & PUBLIC SAFETY

Phase-out or Label Products Containing Genetically Engineered Ingredients

Shareholder activists request companies engaged in the development of genetically modified agricultural products (GMOs) to adopt a policy of not marketing or distributing such products until long term safety testing demonstrates that they are not harmful to humans, animals or the environment. Until further long term testing demonstrates that these products are not harmful, companies in the restaurant, prepared foods and packaging industries are being asked to remove genetically altered ingredients from products they manufacture, distribute or sell, and label such products in the interim. Shareholders are asking supermarket companies to do the same for their own private label brands.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to label products that contain genetically engineered products;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals calling for a full phase out of product lines containing GMO ingredients.

Tobacco-Related Proposals

Shareholders file resolutions annually asking that companies with ties to the tobacco industry account for their marketing and distribution strategies, particularly as they impact smoking by young people. While the specific resolutions for shareholder proponents vary from year to year, activist shareholders consistently make the tobacco industry one of their most prominent targets. Examples of tobacco proposals include: attempting to link executive compensation with teen smoking rates; the placement of company tobacco products in retail outlets; the impact of second hand smoke; and a review of advertising campaigns and their impact on children and minority groups.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking to limit the sale of tobacco products to minors;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals calling for a full phase out of tobacco related product lines.

Toxic Emissions

Shareholder proposals asking companies to take steps to minimize their emissions of toxic chemicals or release of toxic waster into the environment can vary greatly. Some focus on reporting on the impact of these

 

B-194


Table of Contents

chemicals on the communities in which the company operates. Still others ask for a review of the company’s efforts to minimize pollution.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals calling on the company to establish a plan reduce toxic emissions.

Toxic Chemicals

The use of toxic chemicals in cosmetics, consumables, and household products has become a growing issue of concern for shareholders as international regulations on this topic continue to expand, providing increased scrutiny over potentially toxic materials or compounds used or emitted in the conduct of operations or as an ingredient in consumer goods. Shareholders must recognize the impact that changing regulation and consumer expectations could have on shareholder value and should encourage companies to disclose their policies regarding the use or emission of toxic chemicals. Specific considerations should be made for a company’s geographic markets and the appearance of historical difficulties with controversy, fines, or litigation, requests for disclosure on the potential financial and legal risk associated with toxic chemicals.

 

   

Generally support resolutions requesting that a company discloses its policies related to toxic chemicals;

 

   

Generally support shareholder resolutions requesting that companies evaluate and disclose the potential financial and legal risks associated with utilizing certain chemicals;

Nuclear Safety

These resolutions are filed at companies that manage nuclear power facilities or produce components for nuclear reactors to request disclosure on the risks to the company associated with these operations, including physical security and the potential for environmental damage. Current reporting requirements for companies that operate nuclear facilities are managed by the Nuclear Regulatory Commission (NRC) and include detailed reports on safety and security that are available to the public.

 

   

Generally support shareholder resolutions requesting that companies report on risks associated with their nuclear reactor designs and/or the production and interim storage of irradiated fuel rods.

Concentrated Area Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

The level of pollution resulting from CAFOs has drawn increased attention in recent years as certain legal decisions have established the precedent that a company can be held liable for the actions of the contract farms it sources from. Fines and remediation expenses stemming from these cases have been significant and could have a notable impact on the companies’ operations and shareholder value.

 

   

Generally support resolutions requesting that companies report to shareholders on the risks and liabilities associated with concentrated animal feeding operations (CAFOs) unless the company has publicly disclosed guidelines for its corporate and contract farming operations, including compliance monitoring or if the company does not directly source from CAFOs.

Pharmaceutical Product Reimportation

One of the most visible aspects of the legal and political debate over rising health care costs in the United States can be seen through prescription drug reimportation through Canada. While U.S. and Canadian regulations limit reimportation, several states have taken steps to encourage employees to actively seek less expensive medications through reimportation.

Shareholder action at major pharmaceutical companies has requested increased disclosure of the financial and legal risks associated with company policies, or called on companies to change distribution limits to increase product availability in Canada, thereby encouraging product reimportation to the United States. The level of

 

B-195


Table of Contents

public concern over this issue and associated impact that a poorly developed policy could have on the companies suggest that additional disclosure of company policies related to reimportation could be beneficial to shareholders and generally merits support.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals requesting that companies report on the financial and legal impact of their policies regarding prescription drug reimportation, unless such information is already publicly disclosed.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals requesting that companies adopt specific policies to encourage or not constrain prescription drug reimportation.

Pharmaceutical Product Pricing

Pharmaceutical drug pricing, both within the United States and internationally, has raised many questions of the companies that are responsible for creating and marketing these treatments. Shareholder proponents, activists and even some legislators have called upon drug companies to restrain pricing of prescription drugs.

The high cost of prescription drugs is a vital issue for senior citizens across the country. Seniors have the greatest need for prescription drugs, accounting for about one-third of all prescription drug sales, but they often live on fixed incomes and are underinsured. Today about 20 million elderly people have little or no drug coverage in the U.S. In addition, the uninsured and underinsured pay substantially more for drugs than manufacturers favored customers such as HMOs and Federal agencies.

Proponents note that efforts to reign-in pharmaceutical costs will not negatively impact research and development (R&D) costs and that retail drug prices are consistently higher in the U.S. than in other industrialized nations. Pharmaceutical companies often respond that adopting a formal drug pricing policy could put the company at a competitive disadvantage.

Against the backdrop of the AIDS crisis in Africa, many shareholders have called on companies to address the issue of affordable drugs for the treatment of AIDS, as well as TB and Malaria throughout the developing world. When analyzing such resolutions, consideration should be made of the strategic implications of pricing policies in the market.

 

   

Proposals asking a company to implement price restraints on its pharmaceutical products will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Whether the proposal focuses on a specific drug and region;

 

   

Whether the economic benefits of providing subsidized drugs (e.g., public goodwill) outweigh the costs in terms of reduced profits, lower R&D spending, and harm to competitiveness;

 

   

The extent that reduced prices can be offset through the company’s marketing expenditures without significantly impacting R&D spending;

 

   

Whether the company already limits price increases of its products;

 

   

Whether the company already contributes life-saving pharmaceuticals to the needy and Third World countries;

 

   

The extent to which peer companies implement price restraints.

 

   

Generally support proposals requesting that companies implement specific price restraints for its pharmaceutical products in developing markets or targeting certain population groups.

 

   

Generally support proposals requesting that the company evaluate their global product pricing strategy, considering the existing level of disclosure on pricing policies, any deviation from established industry pricing norms, and the company’s existing philanthropic initiatives.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that call on companies to develop a policy to provide affordable HIV, AIDS, TB and Malaria drugs to citizens in the developing world.

 

B-196


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 

2010 Taft-Hartley International Proxy Voting Guidelines

January 2010

 

 

 

Copyright © 2010 by RiskMetrics Group.

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.

Risk Management  |  RiskMetrics Labs  |  ISS Governance Services  |  Financial Research & Analysis

www.riskmetrics.com

 

B-197


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

  

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

     B-200   

FINANCIAL RESULTS/DIRECTOR AND AUDITOR REPORTS

     B-200   

APPOINTMENT OF AUDITORS AND AUDITOR COMPENSATION

     B-201   

Ratifying Auditors

     B-201   

APPOINTMENT OF INTERNAL STATUTORY AUDITORS

     B-202   

ALLOCATION OF INCOME

     B-202   

STOCK (SCRIP) DIVIDEND ALTERNATIVE AND DIVIDEND REINVESTMENT PLANS

     B-203   

AMENDMENTS TO ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

     B-203   

CHANGE IN COMPANY FISCAL TERM

     B-204   

LOWER DISCLOSURE THRESHOLD FOR STOCK OWNERSHIP

     B-204   

TRANSACT OTHER BUSINESS

     B-204   

DIRECTOR AND SUPERVISORY BOARD MEMBER ELECTIONS

     B-205   

CONTESTED DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

     B-208   

DIRECTOR FEES

     B-209   

DISCHARGE OF BOARD AND MANAGEMENT

     B-209   

DIRECTOR AND OFFICER LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION, AND AUDITOR INDEMNIFICATION

     B-210   

BOARD STRUCTURE

     B-211   

Board Size

     B-211   

Adopt Classified Board

     B-211   

Introduction of Mandatory Age of Retirement

     B-212   

Altering Board Size

     B-212   

CAPITAL SYSTEMS

     B-212   

Authorized Capital System

     B-212   

Conditional Capital System

     B-212   

SHARE ISSUANCE REQUESTS

     B-213   

General Issuances

     B-213   

Specific Issuances

     B-213   

INCREASES IN AUTHORIZED CAPITAL

     B-214   

REDUCTION OF CAPITAL

     B-214   

CAPITAL STRUCTURES

     B-215   

PREFERRED STOCK

     B-215   

BLANK CHECK PREFERRED STOCK

     B-216   

DEBT ISSUANCE REQUESTS

     B-217   

PLEDGING OF ASSETS FOR DEBT

     B-217   

INCREASE IN BORROWING POWERS

     B-217   

SHARE REPURCHASE PLANS

     B-218   

REISSUANCE OF SHARES REPURCHASED

     B-219   

CAPITALIZATION OF RESERVES FOR BONUS ISSUES/INCREASE IN PAR VALUE

     B-219   

REORGANIZATIONS/RESTRUCTURINGS

     B-220   

MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS

     B-220   

REINCORPORATION PROPOSALS

     B-222   

EXPANSION OF BUSINESS ACTIVITIES

     B-223   

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

     B-223   

COMPENSATION PLANS

     B-224   

Stock Option Plans

     B-225   

Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options Under the Plan

     B-226   

Exercise Price

     B-226   

Exercise Price Discounts

     B-226   

Plan Administration

     B-226   

Eligibility and Participation

     B-227   

 

B-198


Table of Contents

Performance Criteria and Vesting Provisions

     B-227   

Retesting of Performance Criteria

     B-227   

Other Features Specific to Option Plans

     B-227   

Issue Terms

     B-227   

Option Repricing

     B-227   

Financial Assistance

     B-227   

Plans for International Employees

     B-228   

Stock Appreciation Rights

     B-228   

Phantom Stock Option Plans

     B-228   

Super Options

     B-228   

Restricted Stock

     B-228   

Dividends Under Option and Dividend Equivalent Payment Provisions

     B-228   

Incentive Plans

     B-228   

Share Purchase Plans

     B-229   

Other Features Specific to Share Purchase Plans

     B-229   

Eligibility

     B-229   

Loan Terms

     B-229   

Grants Outside of Plans

     B-230   

ANTITAKEOVER MECHANISMS

     B-230   

Renew Partial Takeover Provision (Australia)

     B-230   

Golden Shares

     B-230   

Poison Pills (Canada)

     B-230   

Depositary Receipts and Priority Shares (The Netherlands)

     B-232   

SHAREHOLDER PROPOSALS

     B-232   

Corporate Governance Proposals

     B-233   

Social and Environmental Proposals

     B-233   

Report on Environmental Policies

     B-234   

Adoption of “CERES Principles”

     B-234   

Adoption of “MacBride Principles”

     B-234   

Contract Supplier Standards

     B-234   

Corporate Conduct and Human Rights

     B-234   

 

B-199


Table of Contents

 

TAFT-HARTLEY ADVISORY SERVICES

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

This statement sets forth the proxy voting policy of RiskMetrics’ Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote the proxies of its clients solely in the interest of their participants and beneficiaries and for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to them. The interests of participants and beneficiaries will not be subordinated to unrelated objectives. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall act with the care, skill, prudence, and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims. When proxies due to Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ clients have not been received, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will make reasonable efforts to obtain missing proxies. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is not responsible for voting proxies it does not receive.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall analyze each proxy on a case-by-case basis, informed by the guidelines elaborated below, subject to the requirement that all votes shall be cast solely in the long-term interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plans. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not intend for these guidelines to be exhaustive. Hundreds of issues appear on proxy ballots every year, and it is neither practical nor productive to fashion voting guidelines and policies which attempt to address every eventuality. Rather, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines are intended to cover the most significant and frequent proxy issues that arise across international markets. Issues not covered by the guidelines shall be voted in the interest of plan participants and beneficiaries of the plan based on a worker-owner view of long-term corporate value. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall revise its guidelines as events warrant.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall report annually to its clients on proxy votes cast on their behalf. These proxy voting reports will demonstrate Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ compliance with its responsibilities and will facilitate clients’ monitoring of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. A copy of this Proxy Voting Policy Statement and Guidelines is provided to each client at the time Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is retained. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall provide its clients with revised copies of this proxy voting policy statement and guidelines whenever significant revisions have been made.

FINANCIAL RESULTS/DIRECTOR AND AUDITOR REPORTS

Vote FOR approval of financial statements and director and auditor reports, unless:

 

   

There are concerns about the accounts presented or audit procedures used; or

 

   

The company is not responsive to shareholder questions about specific items that should be publicly disclosed.

 

   

The company failed to disclose the financial reports in a timely manner.

Discussion

Most companies around the world submit these reports to shareholders for approval, and this is one of the first items on most agendas. The official financial statements and director and auditor reports are valuable documents when evaluating a company’s annual performance. The director report usually includes a review of the company’s performance during the year, justification of dividend levels and profits or losses, special events such as acquisitions or disposals, and future plans for the company.

The auditor report discloses any irregularities or problems with the company’s finances. While a qualified report by itself is not sufficient reason to oppose this resolution, it raises cautionary flags of which shareholders should be aware. Most auditor reports are unqualified, meaning that in the auditor’s opinion, the company’s financial statements are made in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

 

B-200


Table of Contents

When evaluating a company’s financial statements, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks at debt/equity levels on the balance sheet, historical sales and earnings performance, dividend history and payout ratios, and the company’s own performance relative to similar companies in its industry. Unless there are major concerns about the accuracy of the financial statements or the director or auditor reports, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally approves of this item.

APPOINTMENT OF AUDITORS AND AUDITOR COMPENSATION

Ratifying Auditors

Vote FOR the reelection of auditors and proposals authorizing the board to fix auditor fees, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the procedures used by the auditor;

 

   

There is reason to believe that the auditor has rendered an opinion, which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

 

   

External auditors have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company;

 

   

Name of the proposed auditors has not been published;

 

   

The breakdown of audit or non-audit fees is not disclosed or provided in a timely manner (in markets where such information is routinely available);

 

   

The auditors are being changed without explanation; or

 

   

Fees for non-audit/consulting services exceed a quarter of total fees paid to the auditor.*

Vote AGAINST auditor remuneration proposals if a company’s non-audit fees are excessive and auditor remuneration is presented as a separate voting item.

In circumstances where fees for non-audit services include fees related to significant one-time capital structure events: initial public offerings, bankruptcy emergencies, and spin-offs; and the company makes public disclosure of the amount and nature of those fees which are an exception to the standard “non-audit fee” category, then such fees may be excluded from the non-audit fees considered in determining the ratio of non-audit to audit fees.

*In the UK, the level of non-audit fees is calculated as non-audit fees over audit fees, which results in higher level of non-audit fees. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services uses a 50% non-audit fee benchmark in this market to determine if non-audit fees are excessive. If non-audit fees exceed 100% of audit fees, then Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote oppose both the auditor and election of audit committee members.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will apply its U.S. policy at U.S. firms incorporated in offshore tax and governance havens that do not qualify for disclosure exemptions, and vote against the reelection of auditors where auditor tenure exceeds seven years.

Discussion

Most major companies around the world use one of the major international auditing firms to conduct their audits. As such, concerns about the quality and objectivity of the audit are minimal, and the reappointment of the auditor is usually viewed as a routine matter. Audit fees tend to be highly competitive and vary little between companies. However, if a company proposes a new auditor or an auditor resigns and does not seek reelection, companies should offer an explanation to shareholders. If shareholders request an explanation for a change in auditor and the company or retiring auditor fails to provide one, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against the election of a new auditor. If an explanation is otherwise unavailable, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against this item.

 

B-201


Table of Contents

 

Many countries also require the appointment of censors, or special auditors who ensure that the board and management are in compliance with the company’s articles. The censors’ role is purely advisory in nature. Proposals to appoint censors are routine, as the censors usually act as a secondary auditor for special audit requirements.

The practice of auditors contributing non-audit services to companies is problematic, as illuminated by the accounting scandals around the world. When an auditor is paid more in consulting fees than for auditing, the company/auditor relationship is left open to conflicts of interest. Because accounting scandals evaporate shareholder value, any proposal to ratify auditors is examined for potential conflicts of interest, with particular attention to the fees paid to the auditor. When fees from non-audit services become significant without any clear safeguards against conflicts of interest, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the auditor’s reappointment.

APPOINTMENT OF INTERNAL STATUTORY AUDITORS

Vote FOR the appointment or reelection of statutory auditors, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the statutory reports presented or the audit procedures used;

 

   

Questions exist concerning any of the statutory auditors being appointed; or

 

   

The auditors have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company.

Discussion

The appointment of internal statutory auditors is a routine request for companies in Latin America, Italy, Spain, Portugal, Japan, and Russia. The statutory auditing board is usually composed of three to five members, including a group chairman and two alternate members, all of whom are expected to be independent. In addition to the regular duty of verifying corporate accounts, the auditor board is responsible for supervising management and ensuring compliance with the law and articles of association. The auditors must perform an audit of the accounts every three months and present to shareholders a report on the balance sheet at the AGM. For most countries, the auditors are elected annually and may seek reelection. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the appointment of statutory auditors unless there are serious concerns about the reports presented or questions about an auditor’s qualifications.

ALLOCATION OF INCOME

Vote FOR approval of the allocation of income, unless:

 

   

The dividend payout ratio has been consistently below 30 percent without adequate explanation; or

 

   

The payout is excessive given the company’s financial position.

Discussion

Many countries require shareholders to approve the allocation of income generated during the year. These proposals usually, but not always, contain an allocation to dividends. When determining the acceptability of this proposal, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services focuses primarily on the payout ratio. Payouts of less than 30 percent or more than 100 percent are a trigger for further analysis. The minimum level of 30 percent is based on a review of international practice. Payouts of more than 100 percent are a signal that the company is dipping into reserves to make the payment.

Further analysis of payout ratios should include the following: an examination of historical payouts to determine if there is a long-term pattern of low payouts; exceptional events that may have artificially modified earnings for the year; the condition of a company’s balance sheet; comparisons with similar companies both domestically and internationally; and the classification of the company as growth or mature.

 

B-202


Table of Contents

 

Justifications for extreme payouts must be reviewed carefully. If the company has an adequate explanation for a certain payout, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the income allocation as proposed. However, if a company has a pattern of low payouts, fails to adequately justify the retention of capital, and is not experiencing above-average growth, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the proposal. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will also vote against the payout if a company appears to be maintaining an excessive payout that may affect its long-term health.

Although dividend payouts are still the predominant form of distribution of capital to shareholders, share buybacks have become more popular in some markets, such as Denmark. In these cases, companies have introduced policies to return capital to shareholders by way of share repurchases instead of through the payment of dividends. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services votes on proposals to omit the payment of a dividend in favor of a share buyback on a case-by-case basis by looking at factors such as whether repurchased shares will be cancelled or may be reissued, tax consequences for shareholders, liquidity of the shares, share price movements and the solvency ratio of the company.

STOCK (SCRIP) DIVIDEND ALTERNATIVE AND DIVIDEND REINVESTMENT PLANS

Vote FOR most stock (scrip) dividend proposals.

Vote AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

Discussion

Stock dividend alternatives, also referred to in some markets as “scrip” dividend alternatives or dividend reinvestment plans (DRIPS), offer shareholders the option of receiving their dividend payment in the form of fully paid ordinary shares and are common proposals worldwide. While dividend payments in the form of shares in lieu of cash do not immediately add to shareholder value, they allow companies to retain cash and to strengthen the position and commitment of long-term shareholders. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is generally supportive of such plans, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes stock dividend proposals that do not allow a cash option unless management shows that the cash outflow is detrimental to the company’s health and to long-term shareholder value.

AMENDMENTS TO ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

Votes on amendments to the articles of association are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to amend a company’s articles of association are usually motivated by changes in the company’s legal and regulatory environment, although evolution of general business practice can also prompt amendments to articles. Such proposals are especially common whenever stock exchange listing rules are revised, new legislation is passed, or a court case exposes the need to close loopholes.

Amendments to articles range from minor spelling changes to the adoption of an entirely new set of articles. While the majority of such requests are of a technical and administrative nature, minor changes in wording can have a significant impact on corporate governance. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services carefully scrutinizes any changes to a company’s articles.

From a company’s perspective, it is often more efficient to adopt a new set of articles than to introduce numerous amendments. However, bundling changes that treat different provisions of the articles into one voting item prevents shareholders from separating items of concern from routine changes. By leaving a shareholder with an all-or-nothing choice, bundling allows companies to include negative provisions along with positive or neutral changes.

 

B-203


Table of Contents

 

When reviewing new or revised articles, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services classifies each change according to its potential impact on shareholder value and then weighs the package as a whole. The presence of one strongly negative change may warrant a recommendation against the resolution. In assigning these classifications, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is not concerned with the nature of the article being amended, but rather focuses on whether the proposed change improves or worsens the existing provision.

The final criterion on which Taft-Hartley Advisory Services bases its decision is whether failure to pass a resolution would cause an immediate loss of shareholder value. In such cases, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports even a bundled resolution that includes negative changes.

CHANGE IN COMPANY FISCAL TERM

Vote FOR resolutions to change a company’s fiscal term unless a company’s motivation for the change is to postpone its annual general meeting (AGM).

Discussion

Companies routinely seek shareholder approval to change their fiscal year end. This is a decision best left to management. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes this resolution only if the company is changing its year-end to postpone its AGM. Most countries require companies to hold their AGM within a certain period of time after the close of the fiscal year. If a company is embroiled in a controversy, it might seek approval to amend its fiscal year end at an EGM to avoid controversial issues at an AGM. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes the change in year-end in these cases.

LOWER DISCLOSURE THRESHOLD FOR STOCK OWNERSHIP

Vote AGAINST resolutions to lower the stock ownership disclosure threshold below 5 percent unless specific reasons exist to implement a lower threshold.

Discussion

Required shareholder disclosure levels vary around the world. Some countries, such as Canada, require the disclosure of any stakes ten percent or higher, while other countries require lower disclosure levels. For example, the United Kingdom requires disclosure of stakes of three percent or greater. In some countries, shareholders may be asked from time to time to reduce the disclosure requirement at a specific company. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support such initiatives as they encourage greater disclosure by the company’s largest shareholders. However, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote AGAINST reductions that are unduly restrictive or could act as a pretext for an antitakeover device.

TRANSACT OTHER BUSINESS

Vote AGAINST other business when it appears as a voting item.

Discussion

This item provides a forum for questions and any other resolutions that may be brought up at the meeting. In most countries this item is a non-voting formality (not requiring a shareholder vote), but companies in certain countries do include other business as a voting item. Because shareholders who vote by proxy cannot know what issues will be raised under this item, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services cannot approve this request when asked for a vote. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recognizes that in most cases this item is a formality or includes discussion that will have no impact on shareholders, shareholders cannot risk the negative consequences of voting in advance on an item for which information has not been disclosed.

 

B-204


Table of Contents

DIRECTOR AND SUPERVISORY BOARD MEMBER ELECTIONS

Vote FOR management nominees in the election of directors, unless:

 

   

Adequate disclosure has not been provided in a timely manner;

 

   

There are clear concerns about the past performance of the company or the board, including;

 

   

Questionable finances or restatements

 

   

Questionable transactions with conflicts of interest

 

   

The board fails to meet minimum corporate governance standards;

 

   

There is a lack of independence on the board and/or its key committees;

 

   

There are any records of abuses against minority shareholder interests;

 

   

The board takes actions that are not in shareholders’ best interests (excessive executive compensation, adopting antitakeover devices, failure to respond to shareholder concerns/wishes, or demonstrating a “lack of duty or care”); or

 

   

The board has been insensitive to labor interests, human rights, supplier codes of conduct, or has engaged in other corporate activities that affect the reputation of the company in the global market.

Generally vote FOR employee and/or labor representatives.

Votes AGAINST/WITHHOLD votes on individual nominees, key committee members or the entire board can be triggered by one or more of the following concerns:

 

   

Lack of a majority independent board;

 

   

Attendance of director nominees at board meetings of less than 75 percent without valid reason or explanation;

 

   

Lack of full independence on key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, and nominating committees);

 

   

Failure to establish any key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, or nominating) including where the board serves in the capacity of a key committee, and where there is insufficient information to determine whether key committees exist, who the committee members are, or whether the committee members are independent;

 

   

Presence of a non-independent board chairman;

 

   

Directors serving on an excessive number of other boards which could compromise their primary duties. In markets where the number of board appointments is routinely available, an excessive number of boards is defined as;

 

   

For non-executive directors, more than five total non-executive directorships.

 

   

For executive directors, i) more than three total non-executive directorships; or ii) other executive or board chair positions.

 

   

For board chairs, i) more than four total non-executive directorships; or ii) more than two board chair positions; or iii) other executive positions.

 

   

The names of nominees are unavailable or not provided in a timely manner (in markets where this information is routinely available);

 

   

Director terms are not disclosed exceed market norms;

 

B-205


Table of Contents

 

   

Egregious actions including;

 

   

Material failures of governance, stewardship, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company

 

   

Failure to replace management as appropriate

 

   

Egregious actions related to the director(s)’ service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.

For bundled director elections, vote AGAINST the entire slate if any of the concerns above apply to a particular nominee.

Discussion

Most countries around the world maintain an Anglo-Saxon board structure, as seen in the United States, in which executive and nonexecutive directors are organized into a single board. However, companies in a number of countries maintain two-tiered board structures, comprising a supervisory board of nonexecutive directors and a management board with executive directors. The supervisory board oversees the actions of the management board, while the management board is responsible for the company’s daily operations. Companies with two-tiered boards elect members to the supervisory board only; management board members are appointed by the supervisory board.

Depending on the country, shareholders will be asked to either elect directors or supervisory board members at annual meetings. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services considers director/supervisory board elections to be one of the most important voting decisions that shareholders make, especially because shareholders are only given the opportunity to review their companies’ operations once a year at the AGM. Thus, if detailed information on boards or nominees is available, analysis to the highest degree possible is warranted. Directors and supervisory board members function as the representatives of shareholders and stakeholders throughout the year and are therefore, a crucial avenue of ongoing influence on management.

Levels of disclosure regarding directors vary widely. In some countries, such as the United Kingdom, Canada, and Australia, companies publish detailed information such as director biographies, share ownership, and related information that aids shareholders in determining the level of director independence. In these cases, we apply standards of board and key board committee independence. In many other countries, the only information available on directors is their names, while still other countries disclose no information at all. In low-disclosure markets where sufficiently detailed information about directors is unavailable, it could be counterproductive to vote against directors on the basis of a lack of information. Opposition to specific nominees or boards should be supported by specific problems or concerns.

While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the annual election of directors, boards in many countries are divided into two or more classes that are elected on a staggered basis. This system of classified boards is common across the world. Only Canadian companies routinely elect the entire board on an annual basis, but even in Canada companies may classify their board if an appropriate amendment is made to the articles. In certain countries, executive directors may be appointed for terms of up to six years, and a company’s articles may give executive directors protected board seats under which they are not subject to shareholder election. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes directors should stand for reelection annually and be accountable to shareholders on an annual basis, and opposes article amendment proposals seeking extensions of director terms. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also opposes protected board seats and preferential treatment of executive directors. In some countries the trend is moving toward limiting terms for directors. In The Netherlands, the corporate governance code recommends that management and supervisory board members be subject to maximum four-year terms. Although we recognize that four-year terms maybe the standard in the some markets, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the election of new directors or the reelection of an existing director when their terms are not disclosed or where their term lengths exceed market norms.

 

B-206


Table of Contents

 

When reviewing director election proposals (where possible given information disclosure), Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines board composition, company performance, and any negative views or information on either the company or individual directors. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services determines the number of executive and independent directors on the board, the existence and composition of board committees, and the independence of the chairman. An independent director is one whose only significant relationship with the company is through its board seat. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services defines members of supervisory boards, which represent organized workers’ interests, as independent. In cases where board composition is of concern, the company’s general health and its recent financial performance may play a part in the evaluation of directors. Individual director information is also considered, including share ownership among director nominees. In markets where board independence composition information is routinely available, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally oppose all non-independent director nominees if the board is not at least 50 percent (majority) independent. For U.S. firms incorporated in offshore tax or governance havens that do not qualify for disclosure exemptions, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will apply its U.S. policy and vote against non-independent director nominees if the board is not two-thirds majority independent or where key board committees are not completely independent.

While complete independence on board committees is widely recognized as best practice, there are some markets in which it is still common to find executive directors serving as committee members. Whenever the level of disclosure is adequate to determine whether a committee includes company insiders, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally vote against these executive directors.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also takes into account the attendance records of directors when such information is provided to shareholders, using a benchmark attendance rate of 75 percent of board meetings. If an individual director fails to attend at least 75 percent of board meetings, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services makes further inquiries to the company regarding the absences. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against/withhold votes from the director unless the company has provided a reasonable explanation for the absences. International companies tend to have directors who reside in other countries on their boards, making attendance difficult. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services understands the difficulties imposed on such directors, failing to attend meetings prevents directors from fulfilling their fiduciary obligations and adequately representing shareholder interests. Other business obligations and conflicting travel schedules are not acceptable reasons for consistently poor attendance records. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the use of teleconferencing and videoconferencing to cope with the increasing time and travel demands faced by directors in global business.

For shareholder nominees, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services places the persuasive burden on the nominee or the proposing shareholder to prove that they are better suited to serve on the board than management’s nominees. Serious consideration of shareholder nominees will be given in cases where there are clear and compelling reasons for the nominee to join the board. These nominees must also demonstrate a clear ability to contribute positively to board deliberations; some nominees may have hidden or narrow agendas and may unnecessarily contribute to divisiveness among directors.

In many countries it is customary to elect a single slate of directors. We do not approve of this practice because shareholders may wish to express differing views as to the suitability of the director nominees and should have the ability to cast ballots with respect to individuals rather than the entire slate. Given improving best practice in more sophisticated markets, which are moving away from single slate director election items, we will generally oppose director nominees if their election is not presented to shareholders as an individual item in these markets, and will oppose slate nominees in markets where the practice is prevalent and there are concerns with a particular director nominee up for election.

In recent years, the concept that directors should not serve on an excessive number of boards has gained more support as a legitimate governance concern. A common view among many investors is that a director will not be an effective monitor on any board if he/she serves on numerous boards. In markets where disclosure is sufficient (such as detailed director biographies which include information on the director’s role on the board and

 

B-207


Table of Contents

other external appointments both in the local market and abroad), and markets permit individual election of directors, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against a candidate when he/she holds an excessive number of board appointments. Executive directors are expected not to hold other executive or chairmanship positions. They may, however, hold up to two other non-executive directorships. Chairmen are expected not to hold other executive positions or more than one other chairmanship position. They may, however, hold up to three other non-executive directorships. NEDs who do not hold executive or chairmanship positions may hold up to four other non-executive directorships. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will take into account board positions held in global publicly-listed companies. An adverse vote will not be applied to a director within a company where he/she serves as CEO or chair; instead, any negative votes will be applied to his/her additional seats on other company boards.

Director accountability and competence have become issues of prime importance given the failings in oversight exposed by the global financial crisis. There is also concern over the environment in the boardrooms of certain markets, where past failures appear to be no impediment to continued or new appointments at major companies and may not be part of the evaluation process at companies in considering whether an individual is, or continues to be, fit for the role and best able to serve shareholders’ interests. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider a potential negative vote at the board, committee, or individual level, if a director has had significant involvement with a failed company, or has in the past appeared not to have acted in the best interests of all shareholders, and/or where substantial doubts have been raised about a director’s ability to serve as an effective monitor of management and in shareholders’ best interests including consideration of past performance on other boards.

CONTESTED DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

For contested elections of directors (e.g. the election of shareholder nominees or the dismissal of incumbent directors) Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the factors below in determining which directors are best suited to add value for shareholders:

 

   

Company performance relative to its peers;

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents;

 

   

Independence of directors/nominees;

 

   

Experience and skills of board candidates and their ability to contribute positively to board deliberations and overall board performance;

 

   

Governance profile of the company;

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment;

 

   

Responsiveness to shareholders;

 

   

Whether a takeover offer has been rebuffed;

 

   

Whether minority or majority representation is being sought.

When analyzing a contested election of directors, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally focuses on two central questions: (1) Have the dissidents proved that board change is warranted? And (2) if so, are the dissident board nominees likely to effect positive change? (i.e., maximize long-term shareholder value)

Discussion

Once fairly infrequent, contested elections, (also referred to as proxy contests) have become increasingly common in recent years as large shareholders, frustrated by poor returns and unresponsive boards, have sought to challenge the status quo. Even when dissidents do not achieve board seats, studies indicate that at least some of their objectives are often achieved because the response to a proxy contest, or one that was narrowly averted,

 

B-208


Table of Contents

usually includes new strategic initiatives, a restructuring program, governance changes, or selected management changes. Based on these considerations, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ framework for the evaluation of contested elections has the ultimate the goal of increasing long-term value for shareholders.

DIRECTOR FEES

Vote FOR proposals to award director fees unless the amounts are excessive relative to other companies in the country or industry.

Vote AGAINST proposals to introduce retirement benefits for nonexecutive directors.

Vote non-executive director compensation proposals that include both cash and share-based components on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote proposals that bundle compensation for both non-executive and executive directors into a single resolution on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Director fees in most countries are not controversial. Fees for nonexecutive directors have been rising in recent years, as such directors around the world are being asked to take on more responsibility for company affairs. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports increases in director fees unless they are excessive relative to fees paid by other companies in the same country or industry. The primary focus of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ evaluation is on fees paid to nonexecutive directors or fees paid to all directors, separate from the salaries of executive directors. In many countries, only an aggregate amount payable to nonexecutives or to all directors is disclosed.

Retirement benefits for nonexecutive directors are inappropriate, as they increase the directors’ financial reliance on the company and could call into question the objectivity of their decision-making. In addition, most directors have served as senior executives of other companies, and adequate retirement benefits should be provided through these companies. The only caveat to this policy would be for professional nonexecutive directors such as those found in the United Kingdom. However, requests for such benefits in the United Kingdom are rare, and the appropriateness of using shareholder funds in this manner is questionable.

DISCHARGE OF BOARD AND MANAGEMENT

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the discharge of the board and management:

Vote AGAINST the discharge of directors, including members of the management board and/or supervisory board, if there is reliable information about significant and compelling controversies that the board is not fulfilling its fiduciary duties warranted by:

 

   

A lack of oversight or actions by board members which invoke shareholder distrust related to malfeasance or poor supervision, such as operating in private or company interest rather than in shareholder interest; or

 

   

Any legal issues (e.g. civil/criminal) aiming to hold the board responsible for breach of trust in the past or related to currently alleged actions yet to be confirmed (and not only the fiscal year in question), such as price fixing, insider trading, bribery, fraud, and other illegal actions; or

 

   

Other egregious governance issues where shareholders will bring legal action against the company or its directors.

 

B-209


Table of Contents

For markets which do not routinely request discharge resolutions (e.g. common law countries or markets where discharge is not mandatory), Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may express its concern with the board in other appropriate agenda items, such as approval of the annual accounts or other relevant resolutions to express discontent with the board.

Discussion

The annual formal discharge of board and management represents shareholder approval of actions taken during the year. Discharge is a tacit vote of confidence in the company’s management and policies. It does not necessarily eliminate the possibility of future shareholder action, although it does make such action more difficult to pursue. Meeting agendas normally list proposals to discharge both the board and management as one agenda item.

This is a routine item in many countries, and discharge is generally granted unless a shareholder states a specific reason for withholding discharge and plans to undertake legal action. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will withhold discharge when there are serious questions about actions of the board or management for the year in question or legal action is being taken against the board by other shareholders. Withholding discharge is a serious matter and is advisable only when a shareholder has concrete evidence of negligence or abuse on the part of the board or management, has plans to take legal action, or has knowledge of other shareholders’ plans to take legal action.

If evidence suggests that one or more board or management members are responsible for problems such as fraud or grave mismanagement, shareholders can withhold discharge from these individuals and pursue further legal action. Poor performance that can be directly linked to flagrant error or neglect on the part of the board or management, or board actions that are detrimental to shareholders’ interests, may also constitute grounds for voting against discharge.

If shareholders approve discharge of the board and management, they may face a greater challenge if they subsequently decide to pursue legal action against these parties. Shareholders would be required to prove that management or the board did not supply correct and complete information regarding the matter in question.

DIRECTOR AND OFFICER LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION, AND AUDITOR INDEMNIFICATION

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, proposals seeking indemnification and liability protection for directors and officers.

Vote AGAINST proposals to indemnify auditors.

Discussion

Management proposals typically seek shareholder approval to adopt an amendment to the company’s charter to eliminate or limit the personal liability of directors to the company and its shareholders for monetary damages for any breach of fiduciary duty to the fullest extent permitted by law. In contrast, shareholder proposals seek to provide for personal monetary liability for fiduciary breaches arising from gross negligence. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recognizes that a company may have a more difficult time attracting and retaining directors if they are subject to personal monetary liability, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes the great responsibility and authority of directors justifies holding them accountable for their actions. Each proposal addressing director liability will be evaluated consistent with this philosophy. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may support these proposals when the company persuasively argues that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may often oppose management proposals and support shareholder proposals in light of our philosophy of promoting director accountability.

 

B-210


Table of Contents

 

Specifically, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose management proposals that limit a director’s liability for (i) a breach of the duty of loyalty, (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or involving intentional misconduct or knowing violations of the law, (iii) acts involving the unlawful purchases or redemptions of stock, (iv) the payment of unlawful dividends, or (v) the receipt of improper personal benefits. In addition, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally oppose proposals to reduce or eliminate directors’ personal liability when litigation is pending against current board members.

By indemnifying its directors and officers, a company promises to reimburse them for certain legal expenses, damages, and judgments incurred as a result of lawsuits relating to their corporate actions, thereby effectively becoming the insurer for its officers and directors (the company usually purchases insurance to cover its own risk). Proposals to indemnify a company’s directors differ from those to eliminate or reduce their liability because with indemnification directors may still be liable for an act or omission, but the company will bear the expense.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote in favor of indemnification proposals that contain provisions limiting such insurance to acts carried out on behalf of the company. The directors covered under the indemnification must be acting in good faith on company business and must be found innocent of any civil or criminal charges for duties performed on behalf of the company. Additionally, the company may persuasively argue that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but we will oppose indemnification when it is being proposed to insulate directors from actions they have already taken.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes providing indemnity insurance to auditors. These payments call into question the objectivity of the auditor in carrying out the audit, as the fees paid on its behalf could be greater than the audit fees alone. Eliminating concerns about being sued for carelessness could also lead to a decrease in the quality of the audit. Given the substantial settlements against auditors in recent years for poor audit practices, the cost of such insurance to the company and its shareholders is unwarranted.

BOARD STRUCTURE

Vote FOR proposals to fix board size.

Vote AGAINST the introduction of classified boards and mandatory retirement ages for directors.

Vote AGAINST proposals to alter board structure or size in the context of a fight for control of the company or the board.

Discussion

Resolutions relating to board structures range from fixing the number of directors or establishing a minimum or maximum number of directors to introducing classified boards and director term limits.

Board Size

Proposals to fix board size are common and are routinely approved. Proposals to establish a range of board size are also frequent; a range of two or three open slots relative to the existing board size is reasonable, as it gives the company some flexibility to attract potentially valuable board members during the year. Latitude beyond this range is inappropriate, however, because companies can use this freedom to hinder unwanted influence from potential acquirers or large shareholders.

Adopt Classified Board

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that all directors stand for reelection every year. All directors should be accountable to shareholders on an annual basis, as the ability to elect directors is the single most important use of the shareholder franchise.

 

B-211


Table of Contents

 

While classified boards are the norm in most countries, some companies have chosen to place their directors up for annual election. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports initiatives to declassify boards and opposes proposals to classify previously unstaggered boards. Classifying the board makes it more difficult to effect a change of control through a proxy contest; because only a minority of the directors are elected each year, a dissident shareholder would be unable to win control of the board in a single election.

Introduction of Mandatory Age of Retirement

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that age should not be the sole factor in determining a director’s value to a company. Rather, each director’s performance should be evaluated on the basis of their individual contribution and experience.

Altering Board Size

Companies may attempt to increase board size in order to add related or like-minded directors to the board. Conversely, establishing a minimum number of directors could make it easier to remove independent directors from the board. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services considers these proposals on a case-by-case basis.

All proposals to alter board size during a proxy fight or other possible contests for control should be opposed. Allowing directors to alter the terms of a contest while it is underway is not in shareholders’ interests, as this tactic could be used to thwart a takeover that is in shareholders’ interests.

CAPITAL SYSTEMS

Companies have one of two main types of capital systems: authorized and conditional. Both systems provide companies with the means to finance business activities, but they are considerably different in structure. Which system is used by a company is determined by the economic and legal structure of the market in which it operates.

Authorized Capital System

The authorized capital system sets a limit in a company’s articles on the total number of shares that can be issued by the company’s board. The system allows companies to issue shares from this preapproved limit, although in many markets shareholder approval must be obtained prior to an issuance. Companies also request shareholder approval for increases in authorization when the amount of shares contained in the articles is inadequate for issuance authorities. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews proposals for such increases based on the following criteria: the history of issuance requests; the size of the request; the purpose of the issuance (general or specific) associated with the increase in authorization; and the status of preemptive rights (see pol.19 and pol.21).

Conditional Capital System

Under the conditional capital system, companies seek authorizations for pools of capital with fixed periods of availability. For example, if a company seeks to establish a pool of capital for general issuance purposes, it requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable piecemeal at the discretion of the board for a fixed period of time. Shares unissued after the fixed time period lapse. This type of authority would be used to carry out a general rights issue or small issuances without preemptive rights.

Requests for a specific issuance authority are tied to a specific transaction or purpose, such as an acquisition or the servicing of convertible securities. Such authorities cannot be used for any purpose other than that specified in the authorization. In this case, a company requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable as needed for the specific purpose requested. This pool of conditional capital also carries a fixed expiration date.

 

B-212


Table of Contents

 

In reviewing these proposals, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services takes into consideration the existence of pools of capital from previous years. Because most capital authorizations are for several years, new requests may be made on top of the existing pool of capital. While most requests contain a provision to eliminate earlier pools and replace them with the current request, this is not always the case. Thus, if existing pools of capital are being left in place, the aggregate potential dilution amount from all capital should be considered.

SHARE ISSUANCE REQUESTS

Vote FOR general issuance requests with preemptive rights up to 50 percent of issued capital;

Vote FOR general issuance requests without preemptive rights up to 10 percent of issue capital; and

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis specific issuance requests with or without preemptive rights up to any amount depending on the purpose for the issuance.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis those issuance requests that exceed one-year periods.

General Issuances

General issuance requests under both authorized and conditional capital systems allow companies to issue shares to raise funds for general financing purposes. Approval of such requests gives companies sufficient flexibility to carry out ordinary business activities without having to bear the expense of calling shareholder meetings for every issuance.

Issuances can be carried out with or without preemptive rights. Preemptive rights permit shareholders to share proportionately in any new issuances of stock. These rights guarantee existing shareholders the first opportunity to purchase shares of new issuances of stock in the class they own in an amount equal to the percentage of the class they already own. Corporate law in many countries recognizes preemptive rights and requires shareholder approval for the disapplication of such rights.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that the ability to increase share capital by 50 percent through a rights issue (with preemptive rights) provides the company with sufficient financing to meet most contingencies. Rights issues for general capital needs of less than 50 percent of outstanding capital warrant shareholder approval. Issuance authorities of more than 50 percent can lead to excessive cash calls on shareholders, requiring them to provide the funds necessary to maintain their relative positions in the company or to accept substantial dilution.

In some cases, companies may need the ability to raise funds for routine business contingencies without the expense of carrying out a rights issue. Such contingencies could include the servicing of option plans, small acquisitions, or payment for services. When companies make issuance requests without preemptive rights, shareholders suffer dilution as a result of such issuances. Therefore, authorizations should be limited to a fixed number of shares or a percentage of capital at the time of issuance. While conventions regarding this type of authority vary widely among countries, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services routinely approves issuance requests without preemptive rights for up to ten percent of a company’s outstanding capital.

In certain markets, issuance requests are made for several years. This is often the case in France, Germany and Spain. In these situations, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider the per annum dilution equivalent as well as consider whether or not the authority can be renewed before the lapse of the specified period. Whenever possible, we will monitor actual share issuances to assure that the company is not abusing the privilege.

Specific Issuances

Specific issuance requests should be judged on their individual merits. For example, a company may request the issuance of shares for an acquisition in the form of a rights issue to raise funds for a cash payment, or else a

 

B-213


Table of Contents

company could request an issuance without preemptive rights for use in a share-based acquisition or issuance to a third party. Such a request could be of any size, and Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support the request as long as the proposal is sound. A more routine request would be an authority to issue shares without preemptive rights for issuance as needed upon conversion of convertible securities or to service a share option plan. These shares can only be used for the purpose defined in the resolution.

INCREASES IN AUTHORIZED CAPITAL

Vote FOR nonspecific proposals to increase authorized capital up to 50 percent over the current authorization.

Vote FOR specific proposals to increase authorized capital to any amount unless the specific purpose of the increase (such as a share-based acquisition or merger) does not meet Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines for the purpose being proposed.

Vote AGAINST proposals to adopt unlimited capital authorizations.

Discussion

Increases in authorized capital are requested both for general financing flexibility and to provide for a specific purpose. Companies need an adequate buffer of unissued capital in order to take advantage of opportunities during the year, and thus they often request increases in authorized capital for no specific purpose other than to retain this flexibility. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that approving such requests is reasonable.

An increase of 50 percent over the existing authorization gives the company sufficient flexibility in any given year but also limits the company’s ability to abuse this privilege. If a company wishes to issue shares for any unforeseen reason during the year that would double (or possibly triple) outstanding share capital, an EGM to seek shareholder approval is justified.

Another important consideration is the status of preemptive rights. Not all countries recognize shareholders’ preemptive rights, and excessive authorizations could lead to substantial dilution for existing shareholders. When preemptive rights are not guaranteed, companies do not need shareholder approval for share issuances as long as the issuance does not result in an increase above the authorized capital limit.

For specific requests, increases in capital up to any size may be justified if the purpose of the new authorization is in shareholders’ interests. Such increases may be needed to fund a variety of corporate activities, and thus each proposal must be reviewed on its individual merits.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against proposals seeking to increase authorized capital to an unlimited number of shares. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not believe that companies need unlimited financial flexibility to transact ordinary business because such an arrangement precludes management from periodically consulting shareholders for new capital. Unlimited authorizations may also be used as antitakeover devices, and they have the potential for substantial voting and earnings dilution. As such, they are not in shareholders’ best interests.

REDUCTION OF CAPITAL

Vote FOR proposals to reduce capital unless the terms are unfavorable to shareholders.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reduce capital in connection with corporate restructurings.

 

B-214


Table of Contents

 

Discussion

Proposals to reduce capital are usually the result of a significant corporate restructuring in the face of bankruptcy. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports such proposals because opposition could lead to insolvency, which is not in shareholders’ interests. Evaluation of this type of proposal should take a realistic approach to the company’s situation.

CAPITAL STRUCTURES

Vote FOR resolutions that seek to maintain or convert to a one share, one vote capital structure.

Vote AGAINST requests for the creation or continuation of dual class capital structures or the creation of new or additional super-voting shares.

Discussion

A key decision for any business is determining its capital structure. When timed correctly, sophisticated capital management — finding the right mix of equity, long-term debt, and short-term financing — can enhance shareholder returns. This process involves coordination of important issues, including dividend policy, tax and interest rates, types of assets, opportunities for growth, ability to finance new projects internally, and cost of obtaining additional capital.

These decisions are best left to a company’s board and senior management, who should be given the latitude to determine the company’s capital structure. However, shareholders should be aware that many financing decisions could have an adverse effect on shareholder returns. For example, additional equity financing may reduce an existing shareholder’s ownership interest and can dilute the value of the investment. Some capital requests can be used as takeover defenses; in response to this situation, company laws establish limits on management’s authority to issue new capital and often require shareholder approval for significant changes in management’s existing authorizations.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports a one share, one vote policy and opposes mechanisms that skew voting rights. Shareholders’ voting rights should accrue in accordance with their equity capital commitment to the company. Dual class capital structures entrench certain shareholders and management, insulating them from possible takeovers or other external influence or action. The interests of parties with voting control may not be the same as those of shareholders constituting a majority of the company’s capital. Additionally, research and market experience have shown that companies with dual class capital structures or other antitakeover mechanisms consistently trade at a discount to similar companies without such structures.

When companies with dual class capital structures seek shareholder approval for the creation of new shares, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes the creation of additional super-voting shares because this perpetuates the dual class structure. If companies are seeking to increase ordinary or subordinate share capital, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews such requests on a case-by-case basis. If the shares are needed for a specific purpose, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will approve as long as the proposal meets the issuance guidelines for specific requests. Refusing such requests could cause an immediate loss of shareholder value by not allowing the company to carry out its ordinary business. However, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes general share creation requests on the grounds that they would perpetuate unequal voting structures. If shareholders routinely approve the creation of ordinary or subordinate voting shares, the company has no incentive to reform its capital structure. By not approving such requests, shareholders can send a signal of dissatisfaction to management.

PREFERRED STOCK

Vote FOR the creation of a new class of preferred stock or for issuances of preferred stock up to 50 percent of issued capital unless the terms of the preferred stock would adversely affect the rights of existing shareholders.

 

B-215


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR the creation/issuance of convertible preferred stock as long as the maximum number of common shares that could be issued upon conversion meets Taft-Hartley Advisory Services guidelines on equity issuance requests.

Vote AGAINST the creation of blank check preferred stock unless the board expressly states that the authorization will not be used as a takeover defense.

Vote proposals to increase blank check preferred authorizations on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST the creation of a new class of preference shares that would carry superior voting rights to the common shares.

Discussion

Preferred stock (also known as preference shares) is an equity security, but it has certain features that liken it to debt instruments, such as fixed dividend payments, seniority of claims relative to regular common stock, and (in most cases) no voting rights except on matters that affect the seniority of preferred stock as a class. Preferred stock usually ranks senior to a company’s ordinary shares with respect to dividends and the distribution of assets or winding down of the company. Companies often request approval for the creation of a new class of preferred stock, the issuance of preferred stock, and the introduction of blank check preferred stock authorization. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that the terms of preferred stock be set out at the time of the issuance or authorization request.

Preferred stock can be an effective means of raising capital without increasing debt levels, especially if a company has recently concluded a series of acquisitions. In determining the acceptability of proposals relating to preferred stock, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines the rights and terms of the proposed shares, including their designation, conditions, restrictions, and limitations. Whether or not the preferred shares carry voting rights is also considered, along with their conversion ratio (if the shares are convertible into common shares). Also important is the company’s justification for issuing or authorizing preferred stock. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that would not result in excessive dilution or adversely affect the rights of holders of common shares.

BLANK CHECK PREFERRED STOCK

Companies may also seek shareholder approval for blank check preferred stock, which are blanket authorities to issue preferred stock under which the directors are allowed to set the size, terms, and recipient of such shares at the time of issuance. Blank check preferred stock can be used for legitimate corporate purposes such as raising capital or making acquisitions. By not establishing the terms of preferred stock at the time the class of stock is created, companies maintain the flexibility to tailor their preferred stock offerings to prevailing market conditions. However, blank check preferred stock can also be used as an entrenchment device. The ability to issue a block of preferred stock with multiple voting or conversion rights to a friendly investor is a powerful takeover defense. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not support the creation of blank check preferred stock unless the board clearly states that the authorization will not be used to thwart a takeover bid.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also considers, on a case-by-case basis, proposals to increase authorizations of blank check preferred stock when shareholders have already approved the class of stock and the company has a history of issuing such stock for legitimate financing purposes. Theoretically, companies with authorized blank check preferred stock can use these shares for antitakeover purposes as long as there are a few shares remaining, as they are free to set voting or conversion terms with each issue. Therefore, an increase in authorization may have little effect on the usage of this stock. In cases where a company has issued preferred stock from its authorization for legitimate financing purposes, there is no reason to object to an increase.

 

B-216


Table of Contents

DEBT ISSUANCE REQUESTS

Vote non-convertible debt issuance requests with or without preemptive rights on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST the creation or issuance of convertible debt with preemptive rights if the conversion increases the company’s share capital by more than 50 percent over the current outstanding capital.

Vote AGAINST the creation or issuance of convertible debt without preemptive rights if the conversion increases the company’s share capital by more than 10 percent over the current outstanding capital.

Vote FOR proposals to restructure existing debt arrangements unless the terms of the restructuring would adversely affect the rights of shareholders.

Discussion

Debt issuance is a popular financing strategy. Debt instruments are often issued with the right to convert into equity securities. Many companies issue debt denominated in currencies other than their own. Bonds may be issued with or without preemptive rights.

Companies routinely issue bonds directly to shareholders in order to raise funds while enjoying low borrowing costs. Convertible bonds give holders the choice of becoming shareholders, thereby increasing the shareholder base and liquidity of the company’s stock, or selling their newly converted shares on the open market. The issuance of unsecured debt often includes warrants, which are detached at the time of bond issuance. Warrants are usually attached to a debt issuance in order to enhance the marketability of the accompanying fixed income security.

When evaluating a debt issuance request, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines the issuing company’s present financial situation. The main factor for analysis is the company’s current debt-to-equity ratio, or gearing level. A high gearing level may incline markets and financial analysts to downgrade the company’s bond rating, increasing its investment risk factor in the process. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services routinely approves of debt issuances for companies when the gearing level is between zero and 50 percent. If the company’s gearing level is higher than 50 percent, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services then factors in other financial statistics, such as the company’s growth over the past five years relative to earnings or market capitalization, recent corporate events that might affect the company’s bottom line (such as the acquisition of a major competitor or the release of a revolutionary product), and the normal debt levels in the company’s industry and country of origin. In the case of convertible bonds, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also takes into consideration the total level of dilution that would result at the time of conversion. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines for capital increases would then be applied.

PLEDGING OF ASSETS FOR DEBT

Vote proposals to approve the pledging of assets for debt on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

In certain countries, shareholder approval is required when a company needs to secure a debt issuance with its assets. In many cases, this is a routine request and is a formality under the relevant law. When reviewing such proposals, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services takes into account the terms of the proposed debt issuance and the company’s overall debt level. If both of these factors are acceptable, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support these requests.

INCREASE IN BORROWING POWERS

Vote proposals to approve increases in a company’s borrowing powers on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

B-217


Table of Contents

 

Vote AGAINST the removal of a limit on borrowing powers.

Discussion

In some countries, companies are required to seek shareholder approval for increases in their aggregate borrowing power authorities. The aggregate limit on the board’s ability to borrow money is often fixed in a company’s articles, and shareholder approval to change this limit is therefore legally required. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that a company’s financing needs are best determined by the board, and modest increases in borrowing powers are necessary to allow the company to take advantage of new acquisition opportunities or to complete development and restructuring projects. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ analysis of borrowing power increase requests take into account management’s stated need for the increase, the size of the increase, and the company’s current gearing level. Large increases in borrowing powers can sometimes result in dangerously high debt-to-equity ratios that could harm shareholder value. If an increase is excessive without sufficient justification and if a company already has exceptionally high gearing compared to its industry, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the request.

SHARE REPURCHASE PLANS

Vote FOR share repurchase programs/market repurchase authorities, unless:

 

   

Maximum volume: 10 percent for market repurchase within any single authority and 10 percent of outstanding shares to be kept in treasury (“on the shelf”);

 

   

Duration does not exceed 18 months;

In addition, vote AGAINST any proposal where:

 

   

The repurchase can be used for takeover defenses;

 

   

There is clear evidence of abuse;

 

   

There is no safeguard against selective buybacks;

 

   

Pricing provisions and safeguards are deemed to be unreasonable in light of market practice.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may support share repurchase plans in excess of 10 percent volume under exceptional circumstances, such as one-off company specific events (e.g. capital re-structuring). Such proposals will be assessed case-by-case based on merits, which should be clearly disclosed in the annual report, provided that following conditions are met:

 

   

The overall balance of the proposed plan seems to be clearly in shareholder’s interests;

 

   

The plan still respects the 10 percent maximum of shares to be kept in treasury.

For Italy and Germany, vote FOR share-repurchase plans and share reissuance plans that would use call and put options if the following criteria are met:

 

   

The duration of the authorization is limited in time to no more than 18 months;

 

   

The total number of shares covered by the authorization is disclosed;

 

   

The number of shares that would be purchased with call options and/or sold with put options is limited to a maximum of five percent of currently outstanding capital (or half of the total amounts allowed by law in Italy and Germany);

 

   

A financial institution, with experience conducting sophisticated transactions, is indicated as the party responsible for the trading; and

 

   

The company has a clean track record regarding repurchases.

 

B-218


Table of Contents

 

Discussion

Proposals regarding share repurchase plans are routine in most countries, and such plans are usually sufficiently regulated by local laws or listing requirements to protect shareholder interests.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks for the following conditions in share repurchase plans: limitations on a company’s ability to use the plan to repurchase shares from third parties at a premium; limitations on the exercise of the authority to thwart takeover threats; and a requirement that repurchases be made at arm’s length through independent third parties and that selective repurchases require shareholder approval.

Some shareholders object to companies repurchasing shares, preferring to see extra cash invested in new businesses or paid out as dividends. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that when timed correctly, stock repurchases are a legitimate use of corporate funds and can add to long-term shareholder returns.

However, in certain instances, share buybacks are used to fund stock option plans. In these cases, cash is being used to fund stock options plans, which in most cases are a form of management compensation. When possible, we will make efforts to learn whether share repurchase plans are being used to fund stock option plans. In these instances, extra scrutiny will be paid, and a repurchase plan may be opposed.

For markets that either generally do not specify the maximum duration of the authority or seek a duration beyond 18 months that is allowable under market specific legislation, we will assess the company’s historic practice. If there is evidence that a company has sought shareholder approval for the authority to repurchase shares on an annual basis, we will support the proposed authority.

REISSUANCE OF SHARES REPURCHASED

Vote FOR requests to reissue any repurchased shares unless there is clear evidence of abuse of this authority in the past.

Discussion

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally believes that properly timed repurchases of company shares can enhance shareholder value and improve general shareholder returns. With good timing and proper safeguards, the same returns and improvements in shareholder value can be generated through the reissuance of the shares repurchased. In most countries, the text of this general mandate provides sufficient shareholder protection to make this item routine. When reviewing such proposals, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services takes into account the country’s legal framework for such reissuances and the company’s history of reissuing shares under the authority.

CAPITALIZATION OF RESERVES FOR BONUS ISSUES/INCREASE IN PAR VALUE

Vote FOR requests to capitalize reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase par value.

Discussion

Companies routinely carry out bonus issues of shares or increases in par value to existing shareholders, usually through the capitalization of reserves from either the share premium reserve or the retained earnings account. Capitalization of these reserves — transferring them into the share capital account — usually requires shareholder approval. These issuances essentially function as dividends.

When companies increase par value or capitalize reserves and distribute new fully paid shares to shareholders free of charge through a bonus issue, there is no cost to shareholders to maintain their stakes and no risk of dilution. This procedure transfers wealth to shareholders and does not significantly impact share value. The only impact on shareholders is that by increasing the number of shares on issue, the company could increase liquidity, enhance marketability, and ultimately expand its shareholder base.

 

B-219


Table of Contents

 

REORGANIZATIONS/RESTRUCTURINGS

Vote reorganizations and restructurings on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to approve corporate reorganizations or restructurings range from the routine shuffling of subsidiaries within a group to major rescue programs for ailing companies. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services usually approves such resolutions unless there are clear conflicts of interest among the various parties, shareholders’ rights are being negatively affected, or certain groups or shareholders appear to be getting a better deal at the expense of general shareholders.

In the case of routine reorganizations of assets or subsidiaries within a group, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ primary focus with the proposed changes is to ensure that shareholder value is being preserved. This includes the effect of the reorganization on the control of group assets, the final ownership structure, the relative voting power of existing shareholders if the share capital is being adjusted, and the expected benefits arising from the changes.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also assesses the proposed restructuring and its impact on job loss with an emphasis on the company’s U.S. operations. In certain circumstances, jobs may be lost due to economic inefficiencies. However, we will not support reorganizations that unnecessarily eradicate employment, harming the beneficiaries, communities, and the company’s economic position.

In the case of a distress restructuring of a company or group, shareholders’ options are far more limited; often, they have no choice but to approve the restructuring or lose everything. In such cases, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services first determines the company’s degree of distress by determining whether or not the company still has a positive net asset value — that is, if realizable assets are greater than liabilities. Although rare, liquidation should be considered an option in these situations.

In most cases, however, the company has a negative asset value, meaning that shareholders would have nothing left after a liquidation. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services seeks to ensure that the degree of dilution proposed is consistent with the claims of outside parties and is commensurate with the relative commitments of other company stakeholders. Existing shareholders usually must accept the transfer of majority control over the company to outside secured creditors. Ultimately, ownership of a small percentage of something is worth more than majority ownership of nothing.

MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS

For every M&A analysis, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews publicly available information as of the date of our analysis and evaluates the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on mergers and acquisitions taking into account the following:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services places emphasis on the offer premium, market reaction, and strategic rationale;

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction will elicit greater scrutiny on a deal;

 

   

Strategic rationale — Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions;

 

B-220


Table of Contents

 

   

Conflicts of interest — Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? We will consider whether any special interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger;

 

   

Governance — impact of the merger on and shareholder rights. Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance;

 

   

The possibility of a high degree of job loss with no reasonable explanation; and

 

   

Any significant reduction in basic labor standards.

Vote AGAINST if the companies do not provide sufficient information upon request to make an informed voting decision.

ABSTAIN if there is insufficient information available to make an informed voting decision.

Discussion

When evaluating the merits of a proposed acquisition, merger, or takeover offer, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services focuses on the financial and corporate governance impact on shareholder value, both in the immediate and long term. The primary concern is to determine whether or not the proposal is beneficial to shareholders’ existing and future earnings stream and to ensure that the impact on voting rights is not disproportionate to that benefit. Generally, we are interested in the long-term shareholder interests as opposed to short-term gains that devalue assets and have a negative impact on workers and communities.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will evaluate proposed mergers by looking at the justification for the merger; whether a reasonable financial arrangement has been proposed and a fairness opinion rendered; and the long-term impact of the business plans of the competing parties. We will assess the impact of the proposed merger on the affected workforce and community. For example, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will assess the proposed merger’s impact on job loss with an emphasis on the company’s U.S. operations. In certain circumstances, jobs may be lost due to economic inefficiencies. However, we will not support mergers that unnecessarily eradicate employment, harming the beneficiaries, and the company’s economic position.

In the case of a cross-border merger, we consider the proposed merger affect on labor standards. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will not support mergers that diminish basic labor standards. The resulting entity should comply with applicable laws and principles protecting employees’ wages, benefits, working conditions, freedom of association, and other rights.

In the case of an acquisition, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines the level of voting or earnings dilution and the logic of the proposed purchase if large share issuances are required. The method of financing is also important, as various methods can result in different valuations than originally perceived. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also checks for an independent valuation of the terms, particularly if the target of the acquisition is not a publicly traded entity or asset and precise market valuations are not readily available.

This is important when determining whether or not a specific premium is justified. Control premiums on acquisitions vary widely depending on the industry, the time period, and the country. During the late 1980s in the United States, control premiums of up to 70 percent in certain sectors were considered reasonable. Broad averages over time indicate that premiums in the range of 20 percent to 30 percent are normal, but this must be evaluated on a case-by-case basis. For publicly traded entities or assets, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks at the price of the acquisition relative to the average market price prior to any announcement, as well as the historical price trends for 60 days prior. For non-publicly traded entities or assets, an independent financial evaluation becomes even more important.

 

B-221


Table of Contents

 

In the case of mergers, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines whether or not the merger makes commercial or strategic sense for the company. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also considers the method of effecting the merger and the ultimate impact on shareholders of the proposed financial and corporate governance structure. While historical relative valuations based on market prices are useful in the financial evaluation process, the often-complicated financial details of such proposals make an independent fairness opinion of extreme importance. The proposed board structure, share capital structure, and relative share ownership of the new company are all important factors for consideration in this evaluation process.

If the details of a given proposal are unclear or not available and a fairness opinion is also not available, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will either abstain on or vote against the proposal. Abstention would most likely be the result of a lack of information about the proposal. If a company is uncooperative in providing information about the proposal or is evasive when responding to questions, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against it.

REINCORPORATION PROPOSALS

Vote reincorporation proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Reincorporation proposals are most commonly seen in Canada, where companies may register under one of the provincial business statutes. However, companies in other countries may also seek shareholder approval to reincorporate in a U.S. state or another country. Many companies, including U.S. companies, choose to reincorporate in places such as Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, or the British Virgin Islands for tax purposes.

When examining a reincorporation proposal, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services first examines the reasons for the move. Sometimes a reincorporation proposal is part of a restructuring effort or merger agreement that contributes significantly to a company’s growth, financial health, and competitive position more than the anticipated negative consequences of incorporating in another province or country. Some reincorporations allow firms to realize lower taxes or incorporation fees. In addition, there may be advantages to incorporating in the province in which the company conducts the bulk of its business.

Companies often adopt a new charter or bylaws with increased protection for management upon reincorporation. For instance, many reincorporation proposals are bundled with the ratification of a new charter that increases the company’s capital stock or imposes a classified board. When such changes to the charter include the addition of negative corporate governance provisions, the impact of these new provisions on shareholders must be balanced against the anticipated benefits of the reincorporation.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that reincorporations to countries, states, or provinces with less stringent disclosure requirements or corporate governance provisions are often management attempts to lessen accountability to shareholders. In such cases, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote AGAINST the proposal. The expenses involved in a change of domicile relating to legal and administrative fees, plus the greater entrenchment such a reincorporation could provide management, would likely harm shareholders’ interests. In cases where companies propose to move to a more protective province or country and supply reasonable financial reasons for doing so, the benefits of the reincorporation must be weighed against the costs of possible management entrenchment.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also considers the reincorporation’s impact on the employment environment. We do not support reincorporations to new jurisdictions that diminish basic labor rights and standards.

 

B-222


Table of Contents

 

EXPANSION OF BUSINESS ACTIVITIES

Vote FOR resolutions to expand business activities unless the new business takes the company into risky areas.

Discussion

Companies are usually required by law to include in their articles of association or memorandum of association specific business purposes in the form of an objects clause. Because most countries require shareholder approval before articles can be amended, any change to the company’s objects clause requires shareholder approval. Countries often seek shareholder approval to amend the objects clause to expand business lines.

Expanding business lines is a decision usually best left to management, but there are some instances where Taft-Hartley Advisory Services withholds support for such changes. If a company has performed poorly for several years and seeks business expansion into a risky enterprise, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services would require further clarification from management regarding the purpose of the expansion. If the company does not provide a satisfactory business plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will not support the proposal. Furthermore, if the company does not adhere to basic labor principles or codes of conduct in the expansion of its business, then Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will not support the proposal. For example, the expansion must comply with applicable laws and regulations, provide legitimate policies regarding workplace health and safety, and recognize basic labor rights. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that these policies and practices affect long-term corporate performance and increase shareholder value.

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, resolutions that seek shareholder approval on related party transactions considering factors including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

The parties on either side of the transaction;

 

   

The nature of the asset to be transferred/service to be provided; the pricing of the transaction (and any associated professional valuation);

 

   

The views of independent directors (where provided);

 

   

The views of an independent financial adviser (where appointed);

 

   

Whether any entities party to the transaction (including advisers) is conflicted; and

 

   

The stated rationale for the transaction, including discussions of timing.

If there is a transaction that RMG deemed problematic and that was not put to a shareholder vote, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may vote against the election of the director involved in the related-party transaction or the full board.

Vote AGAINST related party transactions when details of a particular arrangement are not available.

Discussion

Shareholders are often asked to approve commercial transactions between related parties. A transaction between a parent company and its subsidiary, or a company’s dealings with entities that employ the company’s directors, are usually classified as related party transactions and are subject to company law or stock exchange listing requirements that mandate shareholder approval. Shareholder approval of these transactions is meant to protect shareholders against insider trading abuses.

 

B-223


Table of Contents

 

In most cases, both the rationale and terms of such transactions are reasonable. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks for evidence of an evaluation of the transaction by an independent body, but this is not always available. Unless the agreement requests a strategic move outside the company’s charter or contains unfavorable terms, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support the proposal. However, in many countries, detailed information about related-party transactions is not available. In some cases, no information is available. When sufficient information is not available, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote AGAINST the arrangement.

COMPENSATION PLANS

Vote AGAINST a company’s compensation-related proposal due to one or a combination of several of the following factors:

 

   

The proposed compensation policy/report was not made available to shareholders in a timely manner;

 

   

The level of disclosure of the proposed compensation policy is below what local market best practice standards dictate;

 

   

Concerns exist with respect to the disclosure or structure of the bonus or other aspects of the remuneration policy such as pensions, severance terms, and discretionary payments;

 

   

Concerns exist surrounding the company’s long-term incentive plan(s), including but not limited to, dilution, vesting period, and performance conditions; Excessive severance arrangements/payments;

 

   

Provision of stock option grants, or similarly structured equity-based compensation, to non-executive directors; and/or

 

   

Where boards have, otherwise, failed to demonstrate good stewardship of investors’ interests regarding executive compensation practices.

Vote AGAINST other appropriate resolutions as a measure of discontent against egregious remuneration practices (as a result of one or a combination of several factors highlighted above) or where a company has not followed market practice by submitting a resolution on executive compensation.

A negative vote could be applied to any of the following resolutions on a case-by case basis:

 

   

The (re)election of members of the remuneration committee;

 

   

The discharge of directors; or

 

   

The annual report and accounts.

Failure to propose a resolution on executive compensation to shareholders in a market where this is routine practice may, by itself, lead to one of the above adverse votes regardless of the companies’ remuneration practices.

Management Proposals Seeking Shareholder Approval of the Company’s Compensation Policy (Say on Pay)

Vote on a CASE-By-CASE basis, management proposals seeking ratification of a company’s compensation policy.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that seeking annual shareholder approval of a company’s compensation policy is a positive corporate governance provision, and considers the following compensation best practices in evaluating shareholder votes on corporate compensation practices:

 

   

Appropriate pay-for-performance alignment with emphasis on long-term shareholder value.

 

   

Avoidance of arrangements that risk “pay for failure”.

 

B-224


Table of Contents

 

   

Independent and effective compensation committees.

 

   

Provision of clear and comprehensive compensation disclosures to shareholders.

 

   

Avoidance of inappropriate pay to non-executive directors.

Non-Executive Director Compensation

Vote FOR proposals to award cash fees to non-executive directors unless the amounts are excessive relative to other companies in the country or industry.

Vote on non-executive director compensation proposals that include both cash and share-based components on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote on proposals that bundle compensation for both non-executive and executive directors into a single resolution on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST proposals to introduce retirement benefits for non-executive directors.

Vote AGAINST non-executive director remuneration if documents (general meeting documents, annual report) provided prior to the general meeting do not mention fees paid to non-executive directors.

Vote AGAINST non-executive director remuneration if the company intends to excessively increase the fees in comparison with market/sector practices, without stating compelling reasons that justify the increase.

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide for the granting of stock options, or similarly structured equity-based compensation, to non-executive directors.

Discussion

The recent financial crisis has shown that poor remuneration systems can lead to the inefficient allocation of company resources and can incentivize behavior that is detrimental to long-term shareholder interests. More than ever, shareholders have become concerned with how companies compensate their executives. Scrutiny has been applied to ascertain whether executive pay is appropriate for a company’s size, market, and industry, and whether remuneration structures sufficiently incentivize long-term share value growth and avoid “pay for failure”. In response to this growing trend, many legislatures/regulators have taken steps to strengthen shareholders’ role in the determination of remuneration practices by increasing companies’ disclosure requirements with respect to compensation practices as well as by recommending (or requiring) that companies provide voting resolutions on remuneration practices at their annual shareholder meetings.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports plans that motivate participants to focus on maximizing long-term shareholder value and returns, encourage employee stock ownership, and more closely align employee interests with those of shareholders. However, we recognize that in many markets, the degree of information available to evaluate compensation proposals is usually limited in detail. For this reason, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services applies its compensation policies and methodology to the extent that market disclosure practices allow.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews three main types of compensation plans: stock option plans, incentive plans, and share purchase plans. Also included in this section are grants outside of plans.

Stock Option Plans

Stock option plans grant participants an option to buy company shares at a set price (the exercise price). Shares are usually granted at market prices and may be exercised when the company’s share price reaches the exercise price. Participants may then purchase the promised shares at the strike price and may later sell the shares

 

B-225


Table of Contents

after their purchase (or after a defined holding period when the shares may not be sold). Among the criteria that Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines in evaluating stock option plans are the following, generally organized from criteria of greater importance to criteria of lesser importance:

Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options Under the Plan

The maximum number of shares Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves under a plan depends on the classification of a company’s stage of development as growth or mature. Growth companies are usually smaller, in new industries requiring significant research and development, and have restricted cash flows. A company in an established industry but expanding rapidly, or a mature company that is experiencing an extended period of rapid expansion, may also be classified as growth. Mature companies are characterized by stable sales and revenue growth, production efficiencies resulting from volume gains, and strong cash flow resulting from developed products in the payoff stage.

For mature companies, shares available under stock option plans should be no more than five percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans. For growth companies, shares available should be no more than ten percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans (and five percent under the proposed plan.) For all companies, an absolute number of shares fixed at the time of approval is ideal, but many countries do not include such a limit. In these cases, revolving limits (a certain percentage of issued shares at any one time) of five or ten percent are common. The practice of setting a percentage of shares issuable over a certain number of years before or after the plan is adopted appears to be a compromise between these first two methods. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers plans where the limits are sufficiently spread out, e.g., five percent in five years, ten percent in ten years.

Exercise Price

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that options be priced at 100 percent of the shares’ fair market value on the date of grant. Usually this is taken as the closing price of the company’s shares on the day prior to the date of grant. Some countries determine fair market value as an average of the trading price for the five days prior to the date of grant. This is a common and acceptable practice. Some emerging market countries use a 30-day average or longer to determine fair market value; these resolutions must be reviewed on a case-by-case basis, although provisions of longer than 30 days increase the possibility of discounted options.

Exercise Price Discounts

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services strongly opposes grants of discounted options to both executive and nonexecutive directors. In the absence of vesting periods or performance criteria (see below), discounted option grants to directors amount to a cash bonus at shareholder expense. Under such circumstances, option holders have an incentive to cash in their grants for an immediate return rather than hold on to their options for future gains. This undermines the incentive value underlining these plans. A few countries allow for options to be granted at a discount to market prices. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves of discounts up to 20 percent, but only for grants that are a part of a broad-based employee plan, including all nonexecutive employees.

Plan Administration

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes allowing the administering committee to grant options to itself due to the potential for “backscratching” abuse. Administration of plans should be in the hands of directors who are unable to participate in the plan. Plans administered by the full board should not allow voting by executive directors; plans administered by remuneration committees should be composed entirely of independent directors. Plans that allow nonexecutive directors to participate should not give them any discretion on individual grants; instead, an automatic system of grants should be introduced with fixed annual grants at market prices on a fixed date. Alternatively, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves of separate nonexecutive director option plans with independent administration.

 

B-226


Table of Contents

 

Eligibility and Participation

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers separate plans for employees, directors, and nonexecutive directors, but most plans include all or some combination of these categories of participants. Other global plans distinguish between full-time and part-time employees or establish a set length of service to the company (usually one year) before options may be granted. Most plans allow the administrating committee to select plan participants.

Performance Criteria and Vesting Provisions

Performance criteria and vesting provisions are important considerations when evaluating a compensation plan, and the existence of long vesting provisions and realistic performance criteria are highly preferred. The ultimate goal of share option plans is to tie executive and employee remuneration to company performance and to give key employees and executives incentive to stay with the firm. Generally in markets where disclosure is an issue, if a plan meets all other aspects of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines, these two criteria are not mandatory. However, whenever greater disclosure is the market norm, we will oppose plans that do not include sufficiently challenging performance criteria or carry a minimum three-year vesting period. This information is commonly provided in markets such as the United Kingdom, Canada, The Netherlands and Australia. Finally, any matching shares that are provided by companies should be subject to additional performance conditions.

Retesting of Performance Criteria

Remuneration plans should not allow for the retesting of performance criteria over another time period if these conditions were not met within the initial period. Retesting is destructive to the incentive value of such plans and undermines the worth of performance criteria. Whenever disclosure is sufficient enough to determine if retesting is allowed under a company’s plan, we will take this feature into consideration for our overall evaluation of the plan.

 

Market Specifics:

 

•   In the UK, whether the terms of a compensation plan are to be satisfied by the issuance of new shares or through the use of treasury shares, the maximum commitment of the aggregate awards under all of the company’s plans should not exceed 10% of issued ordinary capital over a rolling 10-year period for broad-based plans. Within these limits, awards for discretionary plans should not exceed 5% for a rolling 10-year period.

 

Other Features Specific to Option Plans

Issue Terms

Some countries require optionees to pay a nominal fee (often equivalent to $0.01) for every option received. This is common and acceptable, although many companies that once enforced this provision are now deleting it from the rules of their plans.

Option Repricing

Some plans include specific provisions allowing for the repricing of options at the board’s discretion. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes plans that include option repricing when the exercise price is reduced in response to a dropping share price. Repricing outstanding options reduces the incentive that options provide to raise the share price for shareholders.

Financial Assistance

Some plans offer participants loans to pay the full exercise price on their options. If loans are part of a company’s option plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a

 

B-227


Table of Contents

broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessary warrant a recommendation against an option plan, but they are taken into consideration in Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ analysis of the plan.

Plans for International Employees

Many overseas companies introduce separate plans or delegate a special section of their option plan to deal with tax considerations raised by having a large number of employees working in other countries. Many of these plans contain provisions that deal directly with particular U.S. tax code provisions on stock options. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services applies the same criteria to these plans as to country-specific plans.

Stock Appreciation Rights

Stock appreciation rights (SARs) allow participants to receive the difference between the exercise price and the market price at the date of exercise. Many companies use SARs in lieu of regular options. While SARs do not result in the dilution associated with large option exercises, there is little difference between an SAR and a regular option from a shareholder perspective because the financial cost to the company is the same. However, SARs do not encourage stock ownership by participants because they involve no purchase or sale of company stock. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews SARs in the context of the option plan under which they are issued.

Phantom Stock Option Plans

Phantom stock options offer participants cash bonuses based on the increase in share price during a set period of time. Phantom plans are distinct from SARs in that they often form their own separate plan. Some companies will create a phantom stock option plan to award employees who reside in countries that do not allow stock-based compensation. Participants are designated a set number of hypothetical (phantom) shares, on which the award is based. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers compensation plans that encourage employee ownership, SARs and phantom options are an effective way to provide incentive.

Super Options

Super options exceed the limits in a particular country for the value of options granted to any one individual, although they are usually tied to significantly more restrictive vesting provisions and performance criteria. U.K. super options, for example, exceed the Association of British Insurers’ recommended limit that options represent no more than four times a participant’s salary, yet the stricter performance criteria and longer vesting periods usually mitigate excessive grants. Additionally, dilution resulting from super options has historically been fairly moderate. Super options appear most often in advanced markets with developed stock option plans.

Restricted Stock

Restricted stock is specifically designated stock offered at a discount to executives, often under U.S. option plans but increasingly among overseas plans as well. Company shares may be granted outright to optionees with no payment required for the receipt of the shares. Such awards can be extremely expensive, as participants exercise awards at fixed prices far below the current market price. If restricted stock is included as part of a stock option plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services expects strict limits on the amount of shares that may be issued in this form.

Dividends Under Option and Dividend Equivalent Payment Provisions

Most holders of stock options do not receive dividend payments. However, some option plans allow participants to receive dividends or dividend equivalent payments prior to the exercise of options. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that any economic benefit derived from option plans should occur at the time of exercise.

 

B-228


Table of Contents

 

Incentive Plans

Share incentive plans tie key employees’ compensation more directly to company performance. Though most popular in the United Kingdom, incentive plans are becoming increasingly popular across the globe. Incentive plans provide participants with free grants of company shares (or, less frequently, cash grants) in proportion with prearranged performance criteria—often earnings per share measured against inflation or total shareholder return. These indicators are frequently compared with those of other firms in the company’s industry or stock market index, creating a benchmark and a further determinant of the number of shares granted to a particular participant. Proponents of incentive plans note that they offer shareholders the potential for less dilution and that they more directly encourage participants to focus on long-term company performance through strict performance criteria tied to more than just share price movements.

Most incentive plans are organized with strict vesting provisions, where participants may not receive the share awards until after a period of three years or more. Many plans also grant a percentage of the total amount reserved for each participant on a sliding scale measured against performance criteria. Performance criteria targets that have been satisfied only to a certain point may represent disbursement of 25 percent of the shares or cash to a participant, while 100-percent satisfaction may represent the full allotment of the grant. From a shareholder perspective, this graduated system of performance criteria is a major advance.

Evaluation of incentive plans is similar to that of option plans in that acceptable dilution and impartial administration and eligibility remain key factors for a positive recommendation. Insufficient performance criteria or abbreviated vesting provisions are deciding factors as well.

Share Purchase Plans

Share purchase plans allow participants to purchase shares in the company, often at a discount to market prices. These plans are often broad-based in nature, as they are usually open to all employees. Other plans operate via monthly deductions from employees’ paychecks, gathered and held for safe keeping by a trust or a bank and used every month or year to purchase company stock.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will approve many of these plans because they encourage wide share ownership in the company among employees. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally approves broad-based, employee-directed share purchase plans with discounts up to 20 percent. Dilution, eligibility, and administration are the key factors in determining Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ recommendation

Other Features Specific to Share Purchase Plans

Eligibility

While eligibility under share purchase plans is evaluated similarly to stock option plans, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services affords more flexibility with the terms of broad-based employee purchase plans. The inclusion of permanent part-time employees and employees who have been with the company for less than one year are provisions of employee plans that are routinely approved.

Loan Terms

Some plans offer participants loans to pay for the shares. If loans are part of a share purchase plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessary warrant a recommendation against a share purchase plan, but they are taken into consideration in Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ analysis of the plan.

 

B-229


Table of Contents

 

Grants Outside of Plans

Resolutions asking shareholders to approve specific grants of shares or cash outside of established plans are problematic. Some companies prefer not to adopt formal share plans, instead asking shareholders to approve yearly grants to specific employees. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that companies make such grants in the context of an established plan.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ primary concern with grants outside of plans is the level of dilution they afford. The number of shares issued as part of the grants, when combined with the number of shares reserved for the company’s other share plans, must fall within acceptable dilution limits. Vesting provisions and performance criteria are also important and are evaluated on the same basis as if the grants were part of a formal plan.

ANTITAKEOVER MECHANISMS

Vote AGAINST all antitakeover proposals unless they are structured in such a way that they give shareholders the ultimate decision on any proposal or offer.

Discussion

Common antitakeover mechanisms include staggered boards, super-voting shares, poison pills, unlimited authorized capital authorizations (including blank check preferred stock), and golden shares. Some of these restrictions are aimed solely at limiting share ownership by foreign or unwanted minority shareholders, and others are designed to preclude an unwanted takeover of the target company by any party. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes all forms of such mechanisms, as they limit shareholder value by eliminating the takeover or control premium for the company. As owners of the company, shareholders should be given the opportunity to decide on the merits of takeover offers.

Renew Partial Takeover Provision (Australia)

Australian law allows companies to introduce into their articles a provision to protect shareholders from partial takeover offers, to be renewed by shareholders every three years. If a partial takeover of the company is announced, directors are required to convene a shareholder meeting at least 15 days before the closing of the offer to seek approval of the offer. If shareholders reject the resolution, the offer is considered withdrawn under company law and the company can refuse to register the shares tendered to the offer. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves of consulting shareholders on takeover offers, and this article provides protection for minority shareholders by giving them ultimate decision-making authority based on their own interests, not the interests of directors or outside parties. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the adoption of this proposal in almost all cases.

Golden Shares

Recently privatized companies across the world often include in their share structure a golden share held by their respective governments. These shares often carry special voting rights or the power of automatic veto over specific proposals. Golden shares are most common among former state-owned companies or politically sensitive industries such as utilities, railways, and airlines. While the introduction of golden shares is not a desirable governance practice, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recognizes the political importance certain companies hold for governments and treats the introduction or amendment of government shares on a case-by-case basis.

Poison Pills (Canada, Japan)

Otherwise known as shareholder rights plans, poison pills are seen primarily in the Canadian and Japanese markets. Companies generally state that they seek to adopt or renew pills in order to protect shareholders against unfair, abusive, or coercive takeover strategies and to give the target company’s board time to pursue alternatives to a hostile takeover bid. Theoretically, the board will refuse to redeem the pill in the face of an unfair offer in order to force a bidder to negotiate for a better offer, at which point it will redeem the pill.

 

B-230


Table of Contents

 

In accomplishing these goals, however, many rights plans place too much of the decision-making powers in the hands of the board and management and out of the hands of shareholders. However, we note that many Canadian companies have adopted new shareholder rights plans that address the concerns of institutional investors, namely providing for three-year sunset provisions, allowing for partial bids to proceed despite board opposition, and curtailing the overall level of discretion afforded the board in interpreting the pills.

Nonetheless, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services guidelines generally do not support the adoption of poison pills on the grounds that they serve to entrench management. Improperly structured rights plans have been used by boards to ward off offers beneficial to shareholders. Current owners should decide who will own the company, with advice and negotiation from the board and management. When considering the merits of a poison pill, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also examines what other antitakeover devices the company has and the company’s treatment of shareholders in past situations.

Poison pills often have a sunset provision, which requires shareholder confirmation of the plan. Most pills have either a three-year or a five-year sunset provision, requiring that shareholders confirm the continuation of the plan three or five years from the date of adoption. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services guidelines support a three-year sunset provision, which affords shareholders the ability to reconsider the plan in light of changing market conditions and to review management’s use of the plan. Canadian pills also typically include of a permitted bid clause, under which the takeover bid must be made on equal terms to all holders of the company’s voting shares; the company must extend the expiration of the bid, usually by 45 or 60 days following the date of the bid. Management sets the terms of the permitted bid clause, and therefore it influences the level of protection that will be provided to shareholders.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services determines whether the permitted bid feature offers shareholders adequate powers relative to the board in the event of a bid not being approved by the board. Allowing shareholders the right to override the board as a means of balancing power is crucial, but the specifics of the permitted bid clause are usually insufficient. Under the clause, a shareholder who is not intent on a complete acquisition but merely wishes to purchase a significant stake in the company may trigger the pill. This gives the board power to deny shareholders the benefit of a large semi-controlling shareholder and precludes partial bids that may be in shareholders’ interests. In addition to the sunset provision and the structure of the permitted bid clause, in order to qualify for approval, a shareholder rights plan must satisfy ALL of the following conditions:

 

   

Permitted bid clause structure: a permitted bid clause must allow for partial bids supported by a majority of shareholders to proceed despite board opposition; bid periods should generally not be greater than 60 days; the clause” should not contain a “toehold provision” that would any person who already controls a specified percentage of shares from making a permitted bid;

 

   

Amendments: the ability of the board to amend key terms of the plan without shareholder approval following initial adoption of the plan must be limited to clerical and typographical changes and changes required to maintain the validity of the rights plan;

 

   

Exchange option: a plan must not contain a provision that would enable the board to issue in exchange for the right, with or without further charge, debt or equity securities, other assets of the company, or any combination thereof;

 

   

Definition of Fair Market Value: the board must not have the discretion to interpret the fair market value of the company’s shares if the board determines that the value was adversely affected by the news of an anticipated or actual bid or by other means of manipulation;

 

   

Affiliates and Associates: the board’s discretion to decide which parties are acting in concert to determine the level of beneficial ownership, which could be used to trigger the pill should be limited and well-defined in the text of the plan;

 

   

Mandatory Waiver: if the board waives the triggering of the pill with respect to one bidder, the board must be required to waive the pill in favor of any subsequent bids, preventing the board from favoring one bid over another regardless of shareholder interests.

 

B-231


Table of Contents

 

Since 2006, the vast majority of Japanese poison pills have been so called “advance warning-type” (“advance notice-type”) defense plans. In these cases, the board announces in advance a set of disclosure requirements it expects any bidder to comply with, as well as a waiting period between the submission of this information and the launch of the bid. As long as the bidder complies with these rules, the company “in principle” will take no action to block the bid, but will allow shareholders to decide.

The exceptions are where the bid is judged to be clearly detrimental to shareholders, such as in situations defined by a Japanese court or in a report of the government’s Corporate Value Study Group. These include greenmail, asset stripping and coercive two-tier offers. Usually, such judgments are made by a “special committee” or “independent committee,” but the committee’s decision is usually subject to being overruled by the board. At some companies the decisions are made by the board with no committee input at all. Advance warning-type defenses do not require shareholder approval, although in most cases companies are choosing to put them to a shareholder vote, as it is believed that doing so will put the company in a stronger position in the event of a lawsuit.

Where a company implements an advance warning-type defense without a shareholder vote, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will similarly examine the details of the plan, and where we deem it to be detrimental to shareholder value, we will consider recommending votes against the company’s representative director(s).

Depositary Receipts and Priority Shares (The Netherlands)

Depositary receipts are an especially common antitakeover defense among large Dutch companies. In the event of a hostile takeover bid, ordinary voting shares are first issued to a company-friendly trust or foundation. The trust or foundation in turn issues depositary receipts, similar to banks in the United States issuing ADRs except that the foundation retains the voting rights of the issued security. The depositary receipts carry only the financial rights attached to the shares (i.e., dividends). In this manner, the company gains access to capital while retaining control over voting rights. Nonvoting preference shares can be issued to trusts or foundations in a similar fashion.

Priority shares, established in a company’s articles, may be awarded with certain powers of control over the rest of the company. In practice, priority shares are held by members of the supervisory board, company-friendly trusts or foundations, or other friendly parties. Depending on the articles, priority shareholders may determine the size of the management or supervisory boards or may propose amendments to articles and the dissolution of the company. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against the introduction of depositary receipts and priority shares.

SHAREHOLDER PROPOSALS

Vote all shareholder proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote FOR proposals that would improve the company’s corporate governance or business profile at a reasonable cost.

Vote AGAINST proposals that limit the company’s business activities or capabilities or result in significant costs being incurred with little or no benefit.

Discussion

Unlike in the United States where shareholders proposals are quite common, they are less common overseas. One market where proposals sponsored by shareholders are more common is the German market. There are two types of such proposals—shareholder proposals and counterproposals. Counterproposals are filed in direct

 

B-232


Table of Contents

opposition to proposals put forward by management at a given shareholder meeting. Many shareholder and counterproposals in Germany focus on environmental and labor issues. The number of shareholder proposals is also on the rise in Canada, although the aggregate annual number still pales in comparison to the U.S. In general shareholder proposals seen at global companies cover a wide variety of issues, including fundamental corporate governance topics, social issues, direct action proposals, as well as many unique proposals.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ position on the issues covered in many of these proposals has already been discussed. Generally, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will evaluate shareholder proposals to determine whether they are in the best economic interests of the participants and beneficiaries we represent. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ clients, not Taft-Hartley Advisory Services, choose the companies in which they invest and, ultimately, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ responsibility is to protect their economic interests. This does not mean, though, that Taft-Hartley Advisory Services must take a short-term approach when evaluating these proposals. Rather, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote in consistency with the economic best interests of the participants and beneficiaries.

In general, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that request the company to furnish information helpful to shareholders in evaluating the company’s operations. In order to intelligently monitor their investments, shareholders often need information best provided by the company in which they have invested. Requests to report such information merit support. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will evaluate proposals seeking the company to cease taking certain actions that the proponent believes is harmful to society or some segment of society with special attention to the company’s legal and ethical obligations, its ability to remain profitable, and potential negative publicity if the company fails to honor the request.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews all shareholder proposals to ascertain whether the proposal is beneficial or detrimental to shareholder value. Most resolutions fall into three basic categories: corporate governance, social, and environmental. While shareholder proposals in most countries are not as prevalent as they are in the United States, they are becoming more common, and standards for reviewing the various types of proposals are necessary.

Corporate Governance Proposals

Corporate governance-related proposals must be evaluated carefully because any changes can dramatically affect shareholder value. Support for such proposals must be measured against the likely impact that approval would have on the company’s operations. If a measure would improve disclosure of company activities in nonstrategic areas and at minimal costs, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the proposal. If a proposal seeks to improve the company’s corporate governance structure, such as adopting board committees, eliminating staggered board structures, or canceling antitakeover instruments, approval is also warranted. However, if acceptance of a proposal is likely to lead to a disruption in board or management operations and to cause the company to incur significant costs without clear benefit, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the proposal.

Social and Environmental Proposals

The voting fiduciary should support social and environmental proposals if they either contribute to the long term interests of plan participants and beneficiaries, or will have no adverse impact on plan participants and beneficiaries.

Global codes of conduct for social, human, and economic standards are an important component in the stability of world economic conditions and in protecting the current lifestyle of plan beneficiaries and participants. Without agreement on international codes, some international companies could pursue a race to the bottom strategy that could ultimately undermine U.S. environmental and economic conditions.

 

B-233


Table of Contents

 

Report on Environmental Policies

These resolutions request the company to disclose its environmental practices. For example, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support proposals calling for a report on hazardous waste policies and issues regarding Maquiladora factories in Mexico.

Adoption of “CERES Principles”

These resolutions call for the adoption of principles that encourage the company to protect the environment and the safety and health of its employees. Many companies have voluntarily adopted these principles. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support these proposals as they often improve the company’s public image, reduce exposure to liabilities, and establish standards so that environmentally responsible companies and markets are not at a competitive financial disadvantage.

Adoption of “MacBride Principles”

These resolutions call for the adoption of the MacBride Principles for operations located in Northern Ireland. They request companies operating abroad to support the equal employment opportunity policies that apply in facilities they operate domestically. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support such proposals as an appropriate obligation for the company to undertake.

Contract Supplier Standards

These resolutions call for compliance with governmental mandates and corporate policies regarding nondiscrimination, affirmative action, work place safety and health and other basic labor protections. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support proposals that:

 

   

seek publication of a “Code of Conduct” to the company’s foreign suppliers and licensees, requiring they satisfy all applicable standards and laws protecting employees’ wages, benefits, working conditions, freedom of association, and other rights.

 

   

request a report summarizing the company’s current practices for enforcement of its Code of Conduct.

 

   

establishes independent monitoring programs in conjunction with local and respected religious and human rights groups to monitor supplier and licensee compliance with the Code of Conduct.

 

   

create incentives to encourage suppliers to raise standards rather than terminate contracts.

 

   

implement policies for ongoing wage adjustments, ensuring adequate purchasing power and a sustainable living wage for employees of foreign suppliers and licensees.

 

   

request public disclosure of contract supplier reviews on a regular basis.

Corporate Conduct and Human Rights

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support proposals that call for the adoption and/or enforcement of principles or codes relating to countries in which there are systematic violations of human rights; such as the use of slave, child, or prison labor; a government that is illegitimate; or there is a call by human rights advocates, pro-democracy organizations, or legitimately-elected representatives for economic sanctions.

 

B-234


Table of Contents

 

SCHEDULE C

Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form

Portfolio Manager Requesting Override/Making Decision:

 

 

Portfolio Management Product Area (check one):

 

¨ Growth         
¨ Value    ¨ International Equity    ¨ Convertible   
¨ Fixed (High Yield)    ¨ Fixed (High Grade)      

Security Issuer:

 

 

Security’s exchange ticker symbol:

 

 

Cusip #:

 

 

# of Shares held/par amount held:

 

 

Percentage of outstanding shares/par amount held:

 

 

Type of accounts holding security: Mutual Funds (name each fund):                                                                          

Separate Accounts (specify number):                                                                                                            

Other (describe):                                                                                                                                             

Applicable Guidelines (check one):

¨ MacKay Standard (A or B)

¨ Other (specify):

¨ N/A

Shareholder/Bondholder/Lender Meeting Date:

 

 

Response Deadline:

 

 

Brief Description of the Matter to be Voted On:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proposal Type (check one):

¨ Management Proposal

¨ Shareholder Proposal (identify proponent:                                                                                            )

 

Recommended vote by issuer’s management (check one):    ¨ For    ¨ Against    ¨ N/A

 

B-235


Table of Contents
Recommended vote by ISS (check one):    ¨ For    ¨ Against
   ¨ Abstain    ¨ N/A
   ¨ No Recommendation   
Portfolio manager recommended vote (check one):    ¨ For    ¨ Against
   ¨ Abstain   

Describe in detail why you believe this override/decision is in the client’s best interest (attach supporting documentation):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the issuer, or its officers or directors, and MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the issuer, including its officers or directors, and any executive officers of MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the proponent of the proxy proposal (if not the issuer) and MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

B-236


Table of Contents

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the proponent of the proxy proposal (if not the issuer) and any executive officers of MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Has anyone (outside of your portfolio management area) contacted you in an attempt to influence your decision to vote this proxy matter?

¨ No        ¨ Yes

If yes, please describe below who contacted you and on whose behalf, the manner in which you were contacted (such as by phone, by mail, as part of group, individually etc.), the subject matter of the communication and any other relevant information, and attach copies of any written communications.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any facts related to this proxy vote that may present a potential conflict of interest with the interests of the client(s) on whose behalf the proxies are to be voted?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Certification:

The undersigned hereby certifies that to the best of his or her knowledge, the above statements are complete and accurate, and that such override/decision is in the client(s)’ best interests without regard to the interests of MacKay Shields or any related parties.

 

Date:

  

 

Name:

  

 

Title:

  

 

 

B-237


Table of Contents

 

Product Head Concurrence with Override Request/Decision:

 

Date:

  

 

Name:

  

 

Title:

  

 

Legal/Compliance Action:

¨ Override/decision approved

¨ Referred to Compliance Committee for Further Consideration

 

Date:

  

 

Name:

  

 

Title:

  

 

 

B-238


Table of Contents

 

MARSICO CAPITAL MANAGEMENT, LLC

PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES

Statement of Policy

1. It is the policy of Marsico Capital Management, LLC (“MCM”) to seek to vote or otherwise process, such as by a decision to abstain from voting or to take no action on, proxies over which it has voting authority in the best interests of MCM’s clients, as summarized here.

 

   

MCM’s security analysts generally review proxy proposals as part of their monitoring of portfolio companies. Under MCM’s investment discipline, one of the qualities that MCM generally seeks in companies selected for client portfolios is good management teams that generally seek to serve shareholder interests. Because MCM believes that the management teams of most companies it invests in generally seek to serve shareholder interests, MCM believes that voting proxy proposals in clients’ best economic interests usually means voting with the recommendations of these management teams (including their boards of directors).

 

   

In certain circumstances, MCM’s vote-by-vote analysis of proxy proposals could lead it to conclude that particular management or board recommendations may not appear as closely aligned with shareholder interests as MCM may deem desirable, or could be disregarded in the best interests of shareholders. In those and other circumstances, MCM may, in its sole discretion, vote against a management or board recommendation (or abstain or take no action) based on its analysis if such a vote appears consistent with the best interests of clients.

 

   

MCM may process certain proxies without voting them, such as by making a decision to abstain from voting or take no action on such proxies (or on certain proposals within such proxies). Examples include, without limitation, proxies issued by companies that MCM has decided to sell, proxies issued for securities that MCM did not select for a client portfolio (such as, without limitation, securities that were selected by a previous adviser, unsupervised securities held in a client’s account, money market securities, or other securities selected by clients or their representatives other than MCM), or proxies issued by foreign companies that impose burdensome or unreasonable voting, power of attorney, or holding requirements. MCM also may abstain from voting, or take no action on, proxies in other circumstances, such as when voting may not be in the best interests of clients, as an alternative to voting with (or against) management, or when voting may be unduly burdensome or expensive, or if MCM may have a material conflict of interest in voting certain proxies and alternative voting procedures are not desirable.

 

   

In circumstances when there may be an apparent material conflict of interest between MCM’s interests and clients’ interests in how proxies are voted (such as when MCM knows that a proxy issuer is also an MCM client), MCM generally will resolve any appearance concerns by causing those proxies to be “echo voted” or “mirror voted” in the same proportion as other votes, by voting the proxies as recommended by an independent service provider, or by abstaining or taking no action. In other cases, MCM might use other procedures to resolve an apparent material conflict.

 

   

MCM may use an independent service provider to assist in voting proxies, keep voting records, and disclose voting information to clients. MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and reports describing the voting of a client’s proxies are available to the client on request.

 

   

MCM seeks to ensure that, to the extent reasonably feasible, proxies for which MCM receives ballots in good order and receives timely notice will be voted or otherwise processed (such as through a decision to abstain or take no action) as intended under MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and procedures. MCM may be unable to vote or otherwise process proxy ballots that are not received or processed in a timely manner due to functional limitations of the proxy voting system, custodial limitations, or other factors beyond MCM’s control. Such ballots may include, without limitation, ballots for securities out on loan under securities lending programs initiated by the client or its custodian, ballots not timely

 

B-239


Table of Contents
 

forwarded by a custodian, or ballots for which MCM does not timely receive essential information such as the proxy proposal itself or modifications to the required voting date. Other ballots may be voted but not counted, or may be counted in an unexpected way, because of factors such as foreign voting requirements or other limitations.

Definitions

2. By “best interests of MCM’s clients,” MCM means clients’ best economic interests over the long term – that is, the common interest that all clients share in seeing the value of a common investment increase over time. Clients may have differing political or social interests, but their best economic interests are generally uniform.

3. By “material conflict of interest,” MCM means circumstances when MCM itself knowingly does business with a particular proxy issuer, other principal proponent of a proposal, or an entity closely affiliated with the proxy issuer or other principal proponent of a proposal, or other circumstances in which MCM may appear to have a significant conflict of interest between its own interests and the interests of clients in how proxies are voted.

Procedures: MCM Invests in Companies With Management Teams That Seek Shareholders’ Best Interests, and Usually Votes Proxies with Management Recommendations

4. MCM’s security analysts generally review proxy proposals as part of their monitoring of portfolio companies. Under MCM’s investment discipline, one of the qualities that MCM generally seeks in companies selected for client portfolios is good management teams that generally seek to serve shareholder interests. Because MCM believes that the management teams of companies it invests in generally seek to serve shareholder interests, MCM believes that voting proxy proposals in clients’ best economic interests usually means voting with the recommendations of these management teams (or their boards of directors). Therefore, when portfolio companies issue proxy proposals, MCM usually votes the proxies with management or board recommendations, because it believes that recommendations by these companies’ managements generally are in shareholders’ best interests, and therefore in the best economic interests of MCM’s clients.

5. In certain circumstances, MCM’s vote-by-vote analysis of proxy proposals could lead it to conclude that particular management or board recommendations may not appear as closely aligned with shareholder interests as MCM may deem desirable, or could be disregarded in the best interests of shareholders. For example, in some circumstances, certain proxy proposals or recommendations by management, shareholders, or other proponents – such as, without limitation, proposals that would affect corporate governance relating to anti-takeover measures, board election requirements, director qualifications, shared board and management responsibilities, capitalization changes, compensation programs, or other matters – could present circumstances in which management recommendations may not appear as closely aligned with shareholder interests as MCM in its sole discretion may deem desirable. In those and other circumstances, MCM may, in its sole discretion, vote against a management or board recommendation (or abstain or take no action) based on MCM’s analysis if in MCM’s view such a vote appears consistent with the best interests of clients. As further examples, in MCM’s sole discretion, it may vote against a management or board recommendation in order to, without limitation, support a shareholder proposal favoring safeguards against potential overreaching by management or enhancements of shareholder control that MCM believes are reasonable or appropriate, or vote against management or board recommendations in order to oppose management proposals that are not shareholder-friendly in MCM’s view.

6. MCM generally considers each proxy proposal on its merits, and periodically reassesses its views of the management teams of the companies that it invests in for clients. A decision to vote against a particular management or board recommendation or to otherwise abstain or take no action on a proxy proposal does not necessarily signal a departure from MCM’s general view that a management team or board is serving the best interests of shareholders. If MCM concludes, in its sole discretion, that a company’s management team or board no longer appears to be serving shareholders’ best interests, MCM may take any action it deems appropriate, including, without limitation, awaiting further developments, voting against selected management or board recommendations, or selling shares of the company.

 

B-240


Table of Contents

 

Procedures: Use of an Independent Service Provider

7. MCM may engage an independent service provider to assist with the administrative and ministerial aspects of proxy voting. The independent service provider may perform functions that include, without limitation, voting proxies for MCM in accordance with MCM’s instructions based on MCM’s Proxy Voting policy, maintaining records of proxy votes, and assisting in preparing certain reports. To minimize the possibility that MCM’s proxy votes could be affected by potential conflicts of interest that may exist between an independent service provider and a proxy issuer, MCM rarely considers directing such a service provider to vote proxies for MCM based on the service provider’s recommendations (although MCM may do so in certain circumstances discussed in “Alternative Procedures for Potential Material Conflicts of Interest” below).

Procedures: Voting/Abstention/No Action/Other Exceptions

8. MCM seeks to ensure that, to the extent reasonably feasible, proxies for which MCM receives ballots in good order and receives timely notice will be voted or otherwise processed as intended under MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and procedures. MCM employs a number of measures, including certain reconciliations and other cross-check procedures, to attempt to verify that proxies are voted or otherwise processed as intended, although such checks may not be feasible or reliable in some cases because of the complexity of the proxy voting process. MCM’s ability to vote or otherwise process proxies may be limited by many factors, including MCM’s dependence on custodians and independent proxy voting service providers to assist in processing proxies. MCM may be unable to vote or otherwise process proxy ballots that are not received or processed in a timely manner due to functional limitations of the proxy voting system, custodial limitations, or other factors beyond MCM’s control. Such ballots may include, without limitation, ballots for securities out on loan under securities lending programs initiated by a client or its custodian, ballots not timely forwarded by a custodian, or ballots for which MCM does not timely receive essential information such as the proxy proposal itself or modifications to the required voting date. Other ballots may be voted but not counted, or may be counted in an unexpected way, because of factors such as foreign voting requirements or other limitations. For example, in a few foreign markets, ballots cast by MCM may not be counted if required powers of attorney between the client and the custodian are not maintained. Also in foreign markets, ballots for securities held by a custodian in an omnibus account for multiple customers may be voted in an unexpected manner if the custodian receives different voting instructions from its customers and cannot split its vote as each customer requested.

9.a MCM may process some proxies without voting them, such as by making a decision to abstain or take no action on such proxies (or on certain proposals within such proxies). For example, if MCM has decided to sell the shares of a company, MCM generally may abstain from voting proxies or may take no action on proxies issued by the company. If MCM receives proxies relating to securities acquired as a result of an account transition (such as, without limitation, securities delivered into a newly opened MCM account that were selected by a previous adviser), MCM may choose to abstain or take no action on the proxies. MCM also may abstain or take no action on proxies issued for other securities that MCM did not select for a client portfolio (such as, without limitation, unsupervised securities held in a client’s account, or money market securities or other securities selected by clients or their representatives other than MCM).

9.b. MCM may abstain or take no action on proxies (or on certain proposals within such proxies) in other circumstances. MCM may determine, for example, that abstaining or taking no action on proxies is appropriate if voting may be unduly burdensome or expensive, such as when foreign proxy issuers impose burdensome or unreasonable voting, power of attorney, or holding requirements, or if MCM may have a material conflict of interest in voting certain proxies and alternative voting procedures are not desirable. MCM also may abstain or take no action when voting may not be in the best interests of clients in MCM’s view, or as an alternative to voting with (or against) management.

10. The procedures in this policy generally apply to all proxy voting matters over which MCM has voting authority, including changes in corporate governance structures, the adoption or amendment of compensation plans (including stock options), and matters involving social issues or corporate responsibility.

 

B-241


Table of Contents

 

Alternative Procedures for Potential Material Conflicts of Interest

11. In certain circumstances such as when the issuer or other proponent of a proxy proposal is also a client of MCM, it is possible that an appearance might arise of a potential conflict between MCM’s interests and the interests of affected clients in how the proxies of that issuer are voted.

12. MCM seeks to vote or otherwise process proxies in the best interests of its clients, and believes that any potential conflict of interest would not actually affect MCM’s voting of the proxies.

13. Nevertheless, when MCM is aware that a material conflict of interest (as defined in section 3 above) between MCM’s interests and clients’ interests may appear to exist, MCM generally will, to avoid appearance concerns, follow an alternative procedure rather than vote or otherwise process ballots in accordance with its own determinations. Such an alternative procedure generally would involve either:

(i) Directing an independent service provider to cause the proxies of those MCM client accounts that MCM is responsible for processing to be “echo voted” or “mirror voted” in the same proportion as the votes of other proxy holders if the service provider indicates it can do so; or

(ii) Directing the proxies of those MCM client accounts that MCM is responsible for processing to be voted in accordance with the recommendations of an independent service provider that MCM may use to assist in voting proxies. This procedure generally may be used if it can be determined that the independent service provider appears able to make such recommendations and vote in an impartial manner. In making this determination, MCM may (1) require the independent service provider to represent or otherwise demonstrate that the service provider faces no conflict of interest with respect to the vote, or (2) ask the independent service provider to disclose to MCM relevant facts concerning the firm’s relationship with the proxy issuer or other persons and certify that the service provider has taken steps to ensure that no actual conflicts exist.

MCM seeks to document the identification of any material conflict of interest and its procedure for resolving the particular conflict.

14. MCM may use other alternative procedures to address circumstances when a material conflict of interest may appear to exist, such as, without limitation:

(i) Notifying affected clients of the conflict of interest (if it is reasonably feasible to do so), and seeking a waiver of the conflict to permit MCM to vote the proxies;

(ii) Abstaining or taking no action on the proxies in cases when, without limitation, service providers cannot echo vote proxies of certain securities (such as those issued by foreign companies), or in other cases when alternative voting procedures are not desirable; or

(iii) Forwarding the proxies to clients so that clients may vote the proxies themselves.

Voting by Client Instead of MCM

15. An MCM client may elect to vote proxies for its own account instead of directing MCM to do so. MCM recommends this approach if a client believes that proxies should be voted based on political or social interests or other client-specific considerations.

16. MCM generally cannot implement client proxy voting guidelines that do not delegate full discretion to MCM, or that are not fully consistent with these procedures. In particular, MCM encourages the client to vote its own proxies if the client seeks to impose client-specific voting guidelines that may be inconsistent with MCM’s policy or with MCM’s vote-by-vote analysis. MCM does not generally advise a client on proxy voting issues when the client retains authority to handle such matters itself.

 

B-242


Table of Contents

 

17. MCM generally may abstain or will take no action on proxy votes relating to legal proceedings such as shareholder class actions or bankruptcy proceedings, or may refer such votes to clients.

Persons Responsible for Implementing MCM’s Policy

18. MCM’s Operations/Client Services staff has primary responsibility for implementing MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and procedures, including ensuring that proxies are timely submitted. MCM also generally uses a service provider to assist in voting proxies, recordkeeping, and other matters.

19. Members of MCM’s Investment staff, such as security analysts, generally review proxy proposals as part of their ongoing assessment of companies.

Recordkeeping

20.a. MCM or a service provider maintains, in accordance with Rule 204-2 under the Investment Advisers Act:

(i) Copies of all proxy voting policies and procedures;

(ii) Copies of proxy statements received (unless maintained elsewhere as described below);

(iii) Records of proxy votes cast on behalf of clients;

(iv) Documents prepared by MCM that are material to a decision on how to vote or memorializing the basis for a decision;

(v) Written client requests for proxy voting information, and

(vi) Written responses by MCM to written or oral client requests.

20.b. MCM seeks to document instances in which it identifies a material conflict of interest, as well as the procedure utilized for resolving the particular conflict. MCM’s Operations/Client Services Department also documents certain other non-routine proxy voting issues, including: the basis for (1) any decision to vote against a management or board recommendation for reasons other than general matters affecting corporate governance issues discussed in section 5 above; and (2) any decision to abstain or take no action on a proxy that is intended by MCM to demonstrate divergence from a management or board recommendation.

20.c. MCM will not document other, more routine instances in which it may take certain actions with respect to a particular proxy, including certain situations identified in this Proxy Voting policy and procedures. MCM generally will not document, for example, the basis for routine decisions (i) to vote against corporate governance proposals such as those described above, or (ii) to abstain or take no action on proxies in circumstances (A) when foreign issuers impose burdensome or unreasonable voting, power of attorney, or holding requirements, (B) when MCM has sold or determined to sell a security, or when MCM did not select the securities for the client portfolio (such as, without limitation, securities that were selected by a previous adviser, unsupervised securities held in a client’s account, or money market securities or other securities selected by clients or their representatives other than MCM), or (C) when other routine situations arise such as those identified in section 9 above. MCM also cannot document decisions not to vote or otherwise process proxies that were not received in good order, not received in a timely fashion, or otherwise not processed for reasons beyond MCM’s control, such as in certain situations addressed in section 8 above.

21. MCM will obtain an undertaking from any service provider that the service provider will provide copies of proxy voting records and other documents promptly upon request if MCM relies on the service provider to maintain related records.

22. MCM or its service provider may rely on the SEC’s EDGAR system to keep records of certain proxy statements issued by domestic (and some foreign) issuers if the proxy statements are maintained by issuers on that system (as is generally true in the case of larger U.S. – based issuers).

 

B-243


Table of Contents

 

23. All proxy-related records will be maintained in an easily accessible place for five years (and at an appropriate office of MCM or a service provider for the first two years).

Availability of Policy and Proxy Voting Records to Clients

24. MCM will initially inform clients of this policy and provide information regarding how a client may learn of MCM’s voting record for the client’s securities through summary disclosure in Part II of MCM’s Form ADV. Upon receipt of a client’s request for more information, MCM will provide the client with a copy of this Proxy Voting policy. Reports describing how MCM voted proxies for the client during the period since this policy was adopted are also available upon request.

* * *

MCM’s Chief Compliance Officer will review this policy at least annually to determine whether it should be amended or updated. Any amendments to this policy require the written approval of the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

Approved by:    Steven Carlson /s/
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    October 1, 2004
Policy Amended:    February 10, 2006
Approved by:    Steven Carlson /s/
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    February 10, 2006
Policy Amended:    July 19, 2006
Approved by:    Steven Carlson /s/
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    July 19, 2006
Amendment Approved:    August 8, 2008
Approved by:    Steven Carlson
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    September 1, 2008

 

B-244


Table of Contents

 

 

 

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

PROXY VOTING POLICY

 

B-245


Table of Contents

 

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

PROXY VOTING POLICY

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

I.   

OBJECTIVE

     B-28   
II.   

ACCOUNTS FOR WHICH BRANDES HAS PROXY VOTING RESPONSIBILITY

     B-28   
III.   

ADHERENCE TO CLIENT PROXY VOTING POLICIES

     B-29   
IV.   

ARRANGEMENTS WITH Proxy Service Providers

     B-29   
V.   

CONFLICTS

     B-30   
VI.   

SPECIAL ISSUES WITH VOTING FOREIGN PROXIES

     B-30   
VII.   

REPORTS

     B-31   
VIII.   

OPERATIONAL PROCEDURES

     B-31   
  

A.

  

Role of the Reorganization Department

     B-31   
  

B.

  

Role of the Investments Group in Voting Proxies

     B-32   
  

C.

  

Role of the Corporate Governance Committee

     B-32   
  

D.

  

Disclosures of Proxy Voting Intentions

     B-32   
IX.   

SECURITIES SUBJECT TO LENDING ARRANGEMENTS

     B-32   
X.   

RECORDKEEPING

     B-32   
XI.   

PROXY VOTING REVIEW COMMITTEE

     B-33   
XII.   

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES SUMMARY

     B-34   
XIII.   

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

     B-34   
  

A.

  

The Board of Directors

     B-34   
  

B.

  

Auditors

     B-36   
  

C.

  

Proxy Contests, Tender Offer Defenses, and Miscellaneous Governance Provisions

     B-36   
   D.   

Capital Structure

     B-39   
   E.   

Executive and Director Compensation

     B-40   
   F.   

Mergers and Corporate Restructurings

     B-42   
   G.   

Reincorporation

     B-42   
   H.   

Money Market Funds

     B-42   
   I.   

Social, Political, and Environmental Issues

     B-43   
XIV.   

PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES FOR BRANDES INVESTMENT TRUST

     B-43   

 

B-246


Table of Contents

 

EFFECTIVE AS OF

MAY 1, 2009

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

PROXY VOTING POLICY

Brandes Investment Partners, L.P. (“Brandes”) generally is responsible for voting proxies with respect to securities held in client accounts, including clients that are pension plans subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (“ERISA Plans”). This document sets forth Brandes’ policy with respect to proxy voting and its procedures to comply with SEC Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940. Specifically, Rule 206(4)-6 requires that we:

 

   

Adopt and implement written policies and procedures reasonably designed to ensure that we vote client securities in the best interest of clients;

 

   

Disclose to clients how they may obtain information from us about how we voted proxies for their securities; and

 

   

Describe our proxy voting policies and procedures to clients and furnish them a copy of our policies and procedures on request.

I. OBJECTIVE

Where Brandes is given responsibility for voting proxies, we must take reasonable steps under the circumstances to ensure that proxies are received and voted in the best interest of our clients, which generally means voting proxies with a view to enhancing the value of the shares of stock held in client accounts.

The financial interest of our clients is the primary consideration in determining how proxies should be voted. In the case of social, political, and environmental responsibility issues that in our view do not primarily involve financial considerations, it is not possible to represent fairly the diverse views of our clients and, thus, unless a client has provided other instructions, Brandes generally votes in accordance with the recommendations of management and/or a third-party proxy service provider (see discussion below) on these issues, although, on occasion Brandes abstains from voting on these issues.

When making proxy-voting decisions, Brandes generally adheres to its Proxy Voting Guidelines (the “Guidelines”), as revised from time to time by Brandes’ Corporate Governance Committee. The Guidelines are described generally in an insert to our Form ADV, Part II and on our website, and are made available to clients on request. The Guidelines, which have been developed with reference to the positions of certain third party proxy service providers, set forth Brandes’ positions on recurring issues and criteria for addressing non-recurring issues.

II. ACCOUNTS FOR WHICH BRANDES HAS PROXY VOTING RESPONSIBILITY

Brandes generally is responsible for voting proxies with respect to securities selected by Brandes and held in client accounts. Brandes’ form Investment Advisory Agreement provides that Brandes is generally responsible for proxy voting unless the client has directed Brandes to the contrary in writing. As a general rule, Brandes does not, however, vote proxies for securities not selected by Brandes but that are nevertheless held in a client account or where Brandes otherwise is not vested with discretionary authority over securities held in a client account.

Although clients may reserve to themselves or assign to another person proxy voting responsibility, certain formalities must be observed in the case of ERISA Plans. Where authority to manage ERISA Plan assets has been delegated to Brandes, this delegation automatically includes responsibility to vote proxies unless the named

 

B-247


Table of Contents

fiduciary that appointed Brandes has expressly reserved to itself or another named fiduciary proxy voting responsibility. To be effective, a reservation of proxy voting responsibility for a given ERISA Plan should:

 

   

Be in writing;

 

   

State that Brandes is “precluded” from voting proxies because proxy voting responsibility is reserved to an identified named fiduciary; and

 

   

Be consistent with the plan’s documents (which should provide for procedures for allocating fiduciary responsibilities among named fiduciaries).

III. ADHERENCE TO CLIENT PROXY VOTING POLICIES

Although clients do not always have proxy voting policies, if a client has such a policy and instructs Brandes to follow it, Brandes will follow those instructions except in any instance in which doing so would be contrary to the economic interests of the plan or otherwise imprudent or unlawful. In the case of ERISA Plans, Brandes, as a fiduciary, is required to discharge its duties in accordance with the documents governing the plan (insofar as they are consistent with ERISA). These documents include statements of proxy voting policy.

Brandes must, to the extent possible, comply with each client’s proxy voting policy (unless in the particular situation voting in such a manner would be imprudent or otherwise inconsistent with applicable law).

IV. ARRANGEMENTS WITH PROXY SERVICE PROVIDERS

Brandes presently uses the following firms as third-party proxy service providers (“PSP”) to assist in voting proxies.

 

   

Risk Metrics Group (“RMG”) is a proxy research, advisory, voting and vote-reporting service that specializes in global proxy voting. RMG’s primary function with respect to Brandes is to appraise it of shareholder meeting dates of all securities holdings, translate proxy materials received from companies, provide associated research and provide considerations and recommendations for voting on particular proxy proposals.

 

   

Broadridge Financial Solutions’ Proxy Edge service is an electronic proxy voting and vote-tracking service. Broadridge’s primary function with respect to Brandes is to apprise it of the shareholder meeting dates of securities holdings, forward copies of proxy materials, and vote proxies in accordance with our instructions.

 

   

Glass, Lewis & Co., LLC is a leading research and professional services firm that assists institutions globally that have investment, financial or reputational exposure to public companies. It provides research and recommendations for Brandes for voting on proxy proposals.

 

   

Proxy Governance, Inc. provides research and proxy voting recommendations on U.S. and non-U.S. publicly traded companies. Coverage is based on securities held in client portfolios. For non-U.S. companies, research and recommendations may be provided through partnerships with other leading proxy advisory firms, or directly by Proxy Governance when proxy materials are reasonably available in a timely manner.

Although we may consider RMG’s and others’ recommendations on proxy issues, Brandes bears ultimate responsibility for proxy voting decisions. For ERISA Plans for which Brandes votes proxies, Brandes is not relieved of its fiduciary responsibility by following directions of a PSP or the ERISA Plans’ named fiduciaries or by delegating proxy voting responsibility to another person.

 

B-248


Table of Contents

 

V. CONFLICTS

Brandes is sensitive to conflicts of interest that may arise in the proxy decision-making process. For example, conflicts of interest may arise when: (i) proxy votes regarding non-routine matters are solicited by an issuer who has an institutional separate account relationship with Brandes; (ii) Brandes has material business relationships with participants in proxy contests, corporate directors or director candidates; or (iii) a Brandes employee has a material personal interest in the outcome of a particular matter before shareholders.

Brandes is committed to resolving all such and similar conflicts in its clients’ best interests. Brandes has developed these policies and procedures to serve the best interests of its clients, and accordingly, will generally vote pursuant to its Guidelines when conflicts of interest arise. When there are proxy voting proposals, however, that give rise to conflicts of interest that are not addressed by the Guidelines, the Corporate Governance Committee will consult the Head of Compliance (“HOC”) and the approach taken to address the conflict situation shall be documented in writing. If necessary, the Corporate Governance Committee, the HOC, and senior management will consult with an independent consultant or outside counsel to resolve material conflicts of interest. Possible resolutions of such conflicts may include: (i) voting in accordance with the guidance of an independent consultant or outside counsel; (ii) erecting information barriers around the person or persons making voting decisions; (iii) designating a person or committee to vote that has no knowledge of any relationship between Brandes and the issuer, its officers or directors, director candidates, or proxy proponents; or (iv) voting in other ways that are consistent with Brandes’ obligation to vote in its clients’ best interests.

Brandes has taken various steps to neutralize potential conflicts that may arise with PSPs, such as RMG, that also provide other products and services to issuers. RMG has made a copy of its policies, procedures and practices regarding potential conflicts of interest available to Brandes. In addition, RMG shall, on a periodic basis, provide Brandes with a list of those companies that have a business relationship with RMG. Brandes exercises best efforts to compare this list to proxies it votes on behalf of clients so that potential conflicts of interest are made known at the time of voting proxies. In addition, Brandes’ Corporate Governance Committee reviews, not less than annually, potential material conflicts of interest disclosed to Brandes by RMG. Finally, Brandes obtains additional proxy voting information from other PSPs as an additional check on the independence of the voting recommendations provided to Brandes by RMG.

VI. SPECIAL ISSUES WITH VOTING FOREIGN PROXIES

Although Brandes has arrangements with PSPs, voting proxies with respect to shares of foreign companies may involve significantly greater effort and corresponding cost due to the variety of regulatory schemes and corporate practices in foreign countries with respect to proxy voting. Logistical problems in voting foreign proxies include the following:

 

   

Each country has its own rules and practices regarding shareholder notification, voting restrictions, registration conditions, and share blocking.

 

   

To vote shares in some countries, the shares may be “blocked” by the custodian or depository (or bearer shares deposited with a specified financial institution) for a specified number of days (usually five or fewer but sometimes longer) before or after the shareholder meeting. When blocked, shares typically may not be traded until the day after the blocking period. Brandes may refrain from voting shares of foreign stocks subject to blocking restrictions where, in Brandes’ judgment, the benefit from voting the shares is outweighed by the interest of maintaining client liquidity in the shares. This decision generally is made on a case-by-case basis based on relevant factors, including the length of the blocking period, the significance of the holding, and whether the stock is considered a long-term holding.

 

   

Often it is difficult to ascertain the date of a shareholder meeting because certain countries do not require companies to publish announcements in any official stock exchange publication.

 

B-249


Table of Contents

 

   

Time frames between shareholder notifications, distribution of proxy materials, book-closure and the actual meeting date may be too short to allow timely action.

 

   

Language barriers will generally mean that an English translation of proxy information must be obtained or commissioned before the relevant shareholder meeting.

 

   

Some companies and/or jurisdictions require that, in order to be eligible to vote, the shares of the beneficial holders be registered in the company’s share registry.

 

   

Lack of a “proxy voting service” by custodians in certain countries. In countries in which custodians do not offer a “proxy voting service”, Brandes will attempt, on a best efforts basis, to lodge votes in such countries.

 

   

Presence of voting fees in countries in which custodians do not offer a “proxy voting service”, may limit Brandes’ ability to lodge votes in such countries.

Because the cost of voting on a particular proxy proposal could exceed the expected benefit to a client (including an ERISA Plan), Brandes may weigh the costs and benefits of voting on proxy proposals relating to foreign securities and make an informed decision on whether voting a given proxy proposal is prudent.

VII. REPORTS

An insert to Brandes’ Form ADV, Part II and the Brandes website describe how clients may obtain information from Brandes about how we voted proxies with respect to their securities. If requested, Brandes provides clients with periodic reports on Brandes’ proxy voting decisions and actions for securities in their accounts, in such forms or intervals as the clients reasonably request. In the case of ERISA Plans, the named fiduciary that appointed Brandes is required to monitor periodically Brandes’ activities, including our decisions and actions with regard to proxy voting. Accordingly, Brandes provides these named fiduciaries on request with reports to enable them to monitor Brandes’ proxy voting decisions and actions, including our adherence (as applicable) to their proxy voting policies.

VIII. OPERATIONAL PROCEDURES

A. Role of the Reorganization Department

Brandes’ Reorganization Department is primarily responsible for receiving, processing and voting proxies for securities held in the portfolios of our clients.

Once a client account is established, the Reorganization Department will monitor for the client’s custodian to forward proxy materials it receives to Brandes and certain PSPs. The Reorganization Department is also responsible for providing the PSPs with a list of client holdings on a regular basis to enable them to track meeting dates and notify Brandes of upcoming meetings.

The Reorganization Department logs the receipt of the materials from various sources in a pending file until the PSPs provide voting recommendations electronically. The Reorganization Department confirms that the correct amount of shares, as of the record date, is generally reflected on the proxy.

It is Brandes’ general policy to have proxies voted at least forty-eight (48) hours prior to the deadline. Unfortunately, in some instances, proxy materials are received with less than a week’s time before the deadline, and in such cases, Brandes uses reasonable efforts to exercise its vote.

The Reorganization Department also compiles and maintains information, for each client for which Brandes votes proxies, showing the issuer’s name, meeting date and manner in which it voted on each proxy proposal. The Reorganization Department is also responsible for developing compliance procedures with respect to client proxy voting policies.

 

B-250


Table of Contents

 

B. Role of the Investments Group in Voting Proxies

Once the PSP’s recommendations and associated research are received electronically, the recommendations and associated materials are transmitted to the relevant investment research team(s) and/or investment committee(s) for consideration. In determining how to vote a given proxy, Brandes generally adheres to the Guidelines, as revised from time to time by the Corporate Governance Committee, except to the extent superseded by client proxy voting policies. Proposals not covered by the Guidelines and contested situations are, at the relevant analyst’s request, evaluated on case-by-case basis by a member of the Corporate Governance Committee and/or the relevant investment research team(s) or investment committee(s). The firm’s voting decisions are then communicated by the Reorganization Department to Broadridge, or other 3rd party voting agents.

C. Role of the Corporate Governance Committee

Brandes’ Corporate Governance Committee is responsible for setting, reviewing from time to time, but at least annually, and making appropriate changes to the firm’s position on various corporate governance issues, as set forth in the Guidelines. The Corporate Governance Committee shall also provide oversight to the firm’s investment research teams and/or investment committees from time to time on significant proxy voting proposals or issues. Generally, a member of the Corporate Governance Committee must approve a decision to vote proxies contrary to the recommendation of the PSPs.

D. Disclosures of Proxy Voting Intentions

Brandes personnel should not discuss with members of the public how Brandes intends to vote on any particular proxy proposal without the advance approval of its General Counsel. This does not restrict communications in the ordinary course of business with named fiduciaries of ERISA Plans or other clients for which Brandes votes proxies. Disclosure of Brandes’ proxy voting intentions – especially where done with the purpose or effect of influencing the management or control of a company – could trigger various restrictions under the federal securities laws, including under the proxy solicitation, beneficial ownership and short-swing profit liability provisions of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

IX. SECURITIES SUBJECT TO LENDING ARRANGEMENTS

For various legal or administrative reasons, Brandes is often unable to vote securities that are, at the time of such vote, on loan pursuant to a client’s securities lending arrangement with the client’s custodian. Brandes will refrain from voting such securities where the costs to the client and/or administrative inconvenience of retrieving securities then on loan are perceived to outweigh the benefit of voting, assuming retrieval under such circumstances is even feasible and/or possible. In certain extraordinary situations, Brandes may seek to have securities then on loan pursuant to such securities lending arrangements retrieved by the clients’ custodians for voting purposes. This decision will generally be made on a case-by-case basis depending on whether, in Brandes’ judgment, the matter to be voted on has critical significance to the potential value of the securities in question, the relative cost and/or administrative inconvenience of retrieving the securities, the significance of the holding, and whether the stock is considered a long-term holding. There can be no guarantee that any such securities can be retrieved for such purpose.

X. RECORDKEEPING

The Brandes Reorganization Department will maintain copies of the following records for a period of five years, the first two in an easily accessible place, in accordance with the Investment Advisers Act of 1940. Specifically, Rule 204-2 requires that we:

 

   

Copies of all policies and procedures relating to proxy voting.

 

   

A copy of each proxy statement received regarding client securities.

 

B-251


Table of Contents

 

   

A record of each vote cast on behalf of a client.

 

   

A copy of any document created by Brandes that was material to making a decision how to vote proxies on behalf of the client or that memorializes the basis for that decision.

 

   

A copy of each written client request for information on how Brandes voted proxies on behalf of the client, and a copy of any written response by Brandes to any (written and oral) client request for information on how Brandes voted proxies on behalf of the requesting client.

XI. PROXY VOTING REVIEW COMMITTEE

No less frequently than annually, the Proxy Voting Review Committee shall meet to review and discuss the operation of Brandes’ proxy voting procedures. The Committee shall consist of, at least, the following individuals:

 

   

The HOC (who shall act of the Chair of the committee)

 

   

The General Counsel or his/her designee

 

   

A representative of the Corporate Governance Committee

 

   

A representative of the Reorganization Department

 

   

A representative of the Research Department

In reviewing the proxy voting procedures, the Committee shall consider the operation of the policies and procedures since the previous review, including but not limited to the following areas:

 

   

Operational aspects of the policies and procedures (e.g., is information getting to the necessary people in a timely fashion or have any votes been missed)

 

   

Maintenance of all required records

 

   

Performance of service providers (RMG, Broadridge, Glass Lewis and Proxy Governance)

 

   

Conflict of interest issues

 

   

Any instances where Brandes has failed to comply with its policies

 

   

Any suggested revisions to the policies and procedures

The HOC shall meet with the Office of the CEO no less frequently than annually to discuss the results of the Proxy Voting Committee’s review of the policies and procedures.

 

B-252


Table of Contents

 

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

XII. PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES SUMMARY

Summary

With the understanding that many of the issues below are dealt with in detail in these Proxy Voting Guidelines (the “Guidelines”), Brandes’ current policies with respect to a number of more common issues are briefly summarized as follows:

 

   

Brandes typically votes with the recommendations of a company’s Board of Directors on routine or non-controversial issues.

 

   

In general, Brandes opposes anti-takeover proposals and supports the elimination of anti-takeover policies, unless unusual circumstances dictate otherwise.

 

   

In general, Brandes supports proposals that enhance shareholder rights through protecting the ability to call special meetings, act by written consent, access proxy voting materials, and by lowering the requirement for supermajority shareholder vote requirements on certain important governance issues.

 

   

It is not possible to represent fairly the diverse views of our clients on proposals regarding social, political, and environmental issues and, therefore, unless directed by a client to vote in a certain manner, we will generally vote in accordance with the recommendations of management and/or RMG or abstain from voting on the respective issues.

 

   

Proposals not covered by the Guidelines and contested situations will be evaluated on a case-by-case basis by a member of the relevant investment research team(s) or investment committee(s) and/or the Corporate Governance Committee, typically with reference to third-party recommendations and analysis.

XIII. PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

The following guidelines have been developed with reference to the positions of Risk Metrics Group (“RMG”), formerly Institutional Shareholders Services, Inc, (“ISS”). Exceptions and modifications to these guidelines may occur with respect to issues that arise relating to certain companies and/or unique circumstances in certain countries.

A. The Board of Directors

1. Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

We generally support the election of a company’s nominees for director and believe that the board’s nominating committee is in the best possible position to evaluate the qualification of directors and the needs of a particular board. Brandes believes that the election of a majority of independent directors is critical to long term shareholder value. In determining whether to support a board nominee, we will consider the following factors:

 

   

Long-term corporate performance record relative to a market index;

 

   

Composition of board and key board committees;

 

   

Nominee’s attendance at meetings (past two years);

 

   

Nominee’s investment in the company;

 

   

Whether a retired CEO sits on the board; and

 

   

Whether the chairman is also serving as CEO.

 

B-253


Table of Contents

 

In cases of significant votes and when information is readily available, we also review:

 

   

Corporate governance provisions and takeover activity;

 

   

Board decisions regarding executive pay;

 

   

Director compensation;

 

   

Number of other board seats held by nominee; and

 

   

Interlocking directorships.

2. Voting on Director Nominees in Contested Elections

We review on a case-by-case basis the directors nominated for election in contested elections, considering the following factors:

 

   

Long-term financial performance of the target company relative to its industry;

 

   

Management’s track record;

 

   

Background to the proxy contest;

 

   

Qualifications of director nominees (both slates);

 

   

Strategic plan of dissident nominated directors and quality of critique against management;

 

   

Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates);

 

   

Stock ownership positions.

3. Voting on Director Nominees by Bundled Slate

In countries where directors are voted on by slate, we will generally abstain from voting on the board of directors when presented as a slate and there is no disclosure on the individual directors.

Disclosure of director background, experience, performance and accountability to shareholder interests is favored in order that shareholders may vote appropriately for the most qualified director nominees who would add value to the management of the company.

4. Separating Chairman/CEO

We will generally vote for resolutions to separate the Chairman and CEO positions unless the company has a strong countervailing governance structure, which includes an independent lead director that is elected by and from the independent board members with clearly delineated duties, a minimum two-thirds independent board, all key committees comprised of independent directors, and established governance guidelines.

5. Majority of Independent Directors

We vote for shareholder proposals that request that the board be comprised of a majority of independent directors. In determining the independence of a board member, we base the classification on the standards issued by the primary stock exchange in which the company is listed.

We generally vote for shareholder proposals that request that the board audit, compensation and/or nominating committees include independent directors exclusively.

 

B-254


Table of Contents

 

6. Stock Ownership Requirements

We generally vote against shareholder proposals requiring directors to own a minimum amount of company stock in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board.

7. Term of Office

We generally vote against shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors.

8. Director and Officer Indemnification and Liability Protection

Proposals concerning director and officer indemnification and liability protection are evaluated on a case-by-case basis.

We generally vote against proposals to limit or eliminate entirely director and officer liability for monetary damages for violating the duty of care.

We generally vote against indemnification proposals that would expand coverage beyond just legal expenses to acts, such as negligence, that are more serious violations of fiduciary obligations than mere carelessness.

We generally vote for only those proposals that provide such expanded coverage in cases when a director’s or officer’s legal defense was unsuccessful if: (1) the director was found to have acted in good faith and in a manner that he reasonably believed was in the best interests of the company, and (2) only if the director’s legal expenses would be covered.

B. Auditors

We generally rely on the judgment of the board’s audit committee in selecting the independent auditors that will provide the best service to the company. In doing so, we generally support the ratification or reappointment of the company’s auditor unless:

 

   

The auditor has a significant professional or personal relationship with the issuer that compromises the firm’s independence;

 

   

There is reason to believe the auditor has rendered an opinion that is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position; or

 

   

The auditors receive a significant amount of compensation for non-auditing activities or consulting activities.

C. Proxy Contests, Tender Offer Defenses, and Miscellaneous Governance Provisions

1. Board Structure: Staggered vs. Annual Elections

We vote against proposals to classify the board.

We vote for proposals to repeal classified boards and to elect all directors annually.

2. Shareholder Ability to Remove Directors

We vote against proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause.

We vote for proposals to restore shareholder ability to remove directors with or without cause.

 

B-255


Table of Contents

 

We vote for proposals that require director nominees to be elected by the affirmative vote of the majority of votes cast at an annual meeting of shareholders, provided such proposals include adequate provisions which address vote standards in contested elections of directors.

We vote against proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

We vote for proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

3. Cumulative Voting

We will generally vote against proposals to eliminate cumulative voting and will generally vote for proposals to provide for or restore cumulative voting unless the company currently provides for Proxy Access or a similar structure or has adopted a Majority Vote Standard.

In situations where insider voting power is greater than 50%, i.e. controlled company, we will generally vote for proposals to provide for cumulative voting.

4. Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

We vote against proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to call special meetings.

We vote for proposals that remove restrictions on the right of shareholders to act independently of management.

5. Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

We vote against proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to take action by written consent.

We vote for proposals to allow or make easier shareholder action by written consent.

6. Poison Pills

We vote for shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification.

We generally vote for shareholder proposals to redeem a company’s poison pill.

We generally vote against management proposals to ratify a poison pill.

We generally advocate withholding votes from board members who adopt or renew dead-hand poison pills or their variants.

7. Greenmail

We vote for proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

We review on case-by-case basis anti-greenmail proposals, when they are bundled with other charter or bylaw amendments.

 

B-256


Table of Contents

 

8. Unequal Voting Rights

We vote against dual class exchange offers.

We vote against dual class recapitalizations.

9. Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Amend the Charter or Bylaws

We vote against management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve charter and bylaw amendments.

We vote for shareholder proposals to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements for charter and bylaw amendments.

10. Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Approve Mergers

We vote against management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve mergers and other significant business combinations.

We vote for shareholder proposals to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements for mergers and other significant business combinations.

11. Confidential Voting

We generally vote for shareholder proposals that request corporations adopt confidential voting, use independent tabulators and use independent inspectors of elections. We vote for management proposals to adopt confidential voting.

12. Equal Access

We vote for shareholder proposals that would allow significant company shareholders equal access to management’s proxy material in order to evaluate and propose voting recommendations on proxy proposals and director nominees, and in order to nominate their own candidates to the board.

13. Bundled Proposals

We review on a case-by-case basis, bundled or “conditioned” proxy proposals. In the case of items that are conditioned upon each other, we examine the benefits and costs of the packaged items. In instances when the joint effect of the conditioned items is not in shareholders’ best interests, we vote against the proposals. If the combined effect is positive, we support such proposals.

14. Majority-Supported Shareholder Proposals

We will consider a recommendation on withholding votes from board members who fail to take action on shareholder proposals supported by a majority of votes cast for two consecutive years or a majority of shares outstanding for one year on a case-by-case basis. A vote to withhold votes will be based, in part, on the following principles:

 

   

Our “withhold” policy applies to incumbent board members and excludes new nominees to the board (i.e., those being nominated for the first time).

 

   

A board ignoring two different majority-supported proposals in back-to-back years will face a “withhold” recommendation.

 

B-257


Table of Contents

 

   

If after two or more years of majority votes the proposal is not resubmitted, our decision to continue withholding votes in subsequent years will be case-by-case, based on whether or not shareholders are still engaging the company on the issue in some manner, such as a “vote no” campaign.

15. Miscellaneous Governance Provisions

All other governance related issues not specifically addressed elsewhere in these Guidelines are voted on a case-by-case basis upon evaluating each proposal on its merits, based on the particular facts and circumstances.

D. Capital Structure

1. Common Stock Authorization

We review on case-by-case basis proposals to increase the number of shares of common stock authorized for issue.

We vote against proposed common stock authorizations that increase the existing issued share capital by more than 100% unless a clear need for the excess shares is presented by the company.

We vote against proposed common stock authorizations without preemptive rights that are in excess of 5% of the company’s issued share capital.

2. Stock Distributions: Splits and Dividends

We vote for management proposals to increase common share authorization for a stock split, provided that the split does not result in an increase of authorized but unissued shares of more than 100% after giving effect to the shares needed for the split.

3. Blank Check Preferred Authorization

We vote for proposals to create blank check preferred stock in cases when the company expressly states that the stock will not be used as a takeover defense or carry superior voting rights.

We review on a case-by-case basis proposals that would authorize the creation of new classes of preferred stock with unspecified voting, conversion, dividend and distribution, and other rights.

We review on a case-by-case basis proposals to increase the number of authorized blank check preferred shares.

4. Shareholder Proposals Regarding Blank Check Preferred Stock

We vote for shareholder proposals to have blank check preferred stock placements, other than those shares issued for the purpose of raising capital or making acquisitions in the normal course of business, submitted for shareholder ratification.

5. Adjust Par Value of Common Stock

We vote for management proposals to reduce the par value of common stock.

6. Preemptive Rights

We review on case-by-case basis proposals to create or abolish preemptive rights. In evaluating proposals on preemptive rights, we look at the size of a company and the characteristics of its shareholder base.

 

B-258


Table of Contents

 

7. Debt Restructurings

We review on a case-by-case basis proposals to increase common and/or preferred shares and to issue shares as part of a debt-restructuring plan. We consider the following issues:

 

   

Dilution — How much will ownership interest of existing shareholders be reduced, and how extreme will dilution to any future earnings be?

 

   

Change in Control — Will the transaction result in a change in control of the company?

 

   

Bankruptcy — Is the threat of bankruptcy, which would result in severe losses in shareholder value, the main factor driving the debt restructuring?

Generally, we vote for proposals that facilitate debt restructurings unless there are clear signs of self-dealing or other abuses.

8. Share Repurchase Programs

We vote for management proposals to institute open-market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

E. Executive and Director Compensation

In general, we vote on a case-by-case basis on executive and director compensation plans with the view that viable compensation programs reward the creation of shareholder wealth by having high payout sensitivity to increases in shareholder value.

In evaluating a compensation plan, we consider equity-based compensation along with the cash components of pay and attempt to determine the dilutive effect both on shareholder wealth and on voting power. However, in recognition of the fact that it is difficult, if not impossible, for us to develop specific quantitative rules regarding compensation plans that apply to all companies, we instead tend to focus on the following:

 

   

The process used by a company to establish compensation plans. Is it fundamentally sound (i.e., is the process logical; are outside experts employed) and replete with independence?

 

   

The structure of the overall compensation program. Does the total potential compensation (cash and non-cash elements) appear reasonable and fair for this company and industry?

 

   

The link between compensation and the creation of long-term shareholder value. Does the plan:

 

   

Incentivize long-term thinking and stewardship of the company instead of focusing on achieving short-term metrics?

 

   

Provide for adequate compensation to attract and retain competent managerial talent suitable to the challenges and opportunities faced by the individual company?

 

   

Directly tie incentive compensation to performance with above-average rewards only being earned if shareholders are being rewarded with above-average corporate performance?

 

   

Include downside potential as well as up-side rewards without the possibility for a material “second chance” (i.e. repricing of options)?

 

   

Measure performance on clearly objective criteria that are consistent with increases in shareholder value (i.e., ROIC, EVA, etc.)?

 

   

Require significant ongoing share ownership by the executive or director?

 

B-259


Table of Contents

 

Other factors we consider in evaluating compensation plans include the following:

1. Disclosure Policy for Compensation Plans

When reviewing compensation plans in markets where information is limited, at the very minimum, we seek to obtain information regarding (1) the total dilution level and (2) the exercise price.

In markets where certain terms are regularly disclosed and a company has not disclosed this information, we generally a vote against the plan for substandard disclosure.

2. Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation – Say-on-Pay

We will generally vote for shareholder sponsored Say-on-Pay proposals, calling for advisory votes on executive compensation, unless the company currently provides for Proxy Access or a similar structure and/or has adopted a Majority Vote Standard.

In cases where a company has adopted an Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation, we will generally vote on a case-by-case basis, considering the above mentioned factors.

3. Discounted Options and Restricted Stock

We oppose discounted options and restricted stock without performance criteria, with the exception of restricted stock in U.S.-style stock option plans, which will be reviewed on a case-by-case basis.

We consider supporting option plans that allow for discounted options if exercise is contingent on the achievement of well defined and challenging performance criteria.

4. Options Expensing

We will generally vote for shareholder proposals to expense options. We will not support such a shareholder resolution if the company has already publicly committed to expensing options by a specific date.

5. Option Repricing

We generally oppose the repricing of options, which includes all of the following that constitute repricings

 

   

Reduction in exercise price of outstanding options.

 

   

Cancellation and regrant of options at lower exercise prices. This will include 6&1 (six-month and one-day) cancellations/regrants and bullet options (a type of 6&1 with accelerated vesting).

 

   

Substitution of restricted stock for underwater options.

 

   

Buyback of underwater options and issuance of new awards.

6. Performance-Based Stock Options

We will examine shareholder proposals advocating the use of performance-based stock options on a case-by-case basis. Voting decision will therefore take into account the following:

 

   

Whether the proposal mandates that all awards be performance-based.

 

   

Whether the proposal extends beyond executive awards to those of lower ranking employees.

 

   

Whether the company’s stock-based compensation plans meet certain shareholder value transfer criteria and do not violate our repricing guidelines.

 

B-260


Table of Contents

 

7. Plan Amendments

We generally vote for amendments that improve the overall structure of given compensation plan, even if the underlying plan does not necessarily meet our guidelines.

F. Mergers and Corporate Restructurings

1. Mergers and Acquisitions

Votes on mergers and acquisitions are considered on a case-by-case basis, taking into account at least the following:

 

   

Anticipated financial and operating benefits;

 

   

Offer price (cost vs. premium);

 

   

Prospects of the combined companies;

 

   

How the deal was negotiated; and

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights.

2. Corporate Restructuring

Votes on corporate restructuring proposals, including minority squeeze outs, leveraged buyouts, spin-offs, liquidations, and asset sales are considered on a case-by-case basis.

3. Spin-offs

Votes on spin-offs are considered on a case-by-case basis depending on the tax and regulatory advantages, planned use of sale proceeds, market focus, and managerial incentives.

4. Asset Sales

Votes on asset sales are made on a case-by-case basis after considering the impact on the balance sheet/working capital, value received for the asset, and potential elimination of diseconomies.

5. Liquidations

Votes on liquidations are made on a case-by-case basis after reviewing management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives, appraisal value of assets, and the compensation plan for executives managing the liquidation.

6. Appraisal Rights

We vote for proposals to restore, or provide shareholders with, rights of appraisal.

G. Reincorporation

Proposals to change a company’s state or country of incorporation are reviewed on a case-by-case basis, giving consideration to both financial and corporate governance factors including the reason for reincorporation, a comparison of the governance provisions and jurisdictional laws, and potential economic costs and benefits.

H. Money Market Funds

For money market funds in which we have not selected the fund, we will not review proxies, but instead we will vote with the recommendations of a third party proxy service provider on all proposals. In rare circumstances when no such entity provides recommendations, we vote proposals in accordance with the recommendations of management.

 

B-261


Table of Contents

 

I. Social, Political, and Environmental Issues

In the case of social, political, and environmental responsibility issues that in our view do not primarily involve financial considerations, it is not possible to represent fairly the diverse views of our clients and, thus, unless a client has provided other instructions, we generally vote in accordance with the recommendations of RMG on these issues, although, on occasion we abstain from voting on these issues.

XIV. PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES FOR BRANDES INVESTMENT TRUST

The Board of Trustees of Brandes Investment Trust (the “Company”) has adopted the following policy and procedures with respect to voting proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Company’s investment portfolio (“Fund”).

A. Proxy Voting Policy

The policy of the Company is to delegate the responsibility for voting proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Fund to Brandes Investment Partners (the “Adviser”) as a part of the Adviser’s general management of the Fund, subject to the Board’s continuing oversight.

B. Fiduciary Duty

The right to vote proxies with respect to portfolio securities held by the Fund is an asset of the Company. The Adviser acts as a fiduciary of the Fund and must vote proxies in a manner consistent with the best interest of the Fund and its shareholders.

C. Proxy Voting Procedures

 

  1. At least annually, the Adviser shall present to the Board its policies, procedures and other guidelines for voting proxies. In addition, the Adviser shall notify the Board promptly of materials changes to any of these documents.

 

  2. At least annually, the Adviser shall provide to the Board a record of each proxy voted with respect to portfolio securities of the Fund during the year. With respect to those proxies that the Adviser has identified as involving a conflict of interest, the Adviser shall submit a separate report indicating the nature of the conflict of interest and how that conflict was resolved with respect to the voting of the proxy. For this purpose, a “conflict of interest” shall be deemed to occur when the Adviser or an affiliated person of the Adviser has a financial interest in a matter presented by a proxy to be voted on behalf of the Fund, which may compromise the Adviser’s independence of judgment and action in voting the proxy.

D. Revocation of Authority to Vote

The delegation by the Board of the authority to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities of the Fund may be revoked by the board, in whole or in part, at any time.

E. Annual Filing of Proxy Voting Record

 

  1. The Company shall include in its Form N-1A registration statement:

 

  a. A description of this policy and of the policies and procedures used by the Adviser to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities; and

 

B-262


Table of Contents

 

  b. A statement disclosing that information regarding how the Company voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30 is available without charge, upon request, by calling the Company’s toll-free telephone number (or through a specified Internet address or both) and on the SEC website.

 

  2. The Company shall include in it Annual and Semi-Annual Report to shareholders:

 

  a. A statement that a description of the policies and procedures used by or on behalf of the Company to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities of the Fund is available without charge, upon request, by calling the Company’s toll-free telephone number or through a specified Internet address, and on the SEC website.

 

  b. A statement that information regarding how the Company voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30 is available without charge, upon request, by calling the Company’s toll-free number (or through a specified Internet address or both) and on the SEC website.

 

B-263


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C — SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R shares and Class R4 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R shares and Class R4 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1?2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

  * Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

  ** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

 

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

C-3


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX D — DESCRIPTION OF STATE CONDITIONS

STATE SPECIFIC INFORMATION

Each Fund’s investments are highly dependent on and sensitive to the general fiscal and economic stability of the state in which the Fund invests, as well as the general fiscal and economic stability of the state’s subdivisions, agencies, instrumentalities or authorities, which issue the securities in which the Fund invests. The following information supplements information set forth in each Fund’s prospectuses, constitutes only a brief summary and does not purport to be a complete description of certain state-specific considerations and is provided to investors in view of each Fund’s policy of concentrating its investments in securities issued by issuers of a single state. The information is based on publicly available sources and has not been independently verified by the Adviser but is believed to be accurate in all material respects. It is expected that the information will be updated only on an annual basis and thus may be out of date at any time that you make an investment decision to purchase or sell shares of a Fund.

To the extent that any statements made below involve matters of forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates, whether or not expressly stated to be such, they are made as such and not as representations of fact or certainty, and no representation is made that any of these statements has been or will be realized. All forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates are “forward looking statements” that must be read with an abundance of caution and that may not be realized or may not occur in the future.

California

The following information relates specifically to the California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund (the Fund). This summary does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all relevant facts. Although the Fund has no reason to believe that the information summarized below is not correct in all material respects, such information has not been independently verified for accuracy or thoroughness. Rather, this information has been obtained from official statements, prospectuses and other disclosure provided in connection with various securities offerings of the State of California (California or the State) and local agencies in California available as of the date of this Statement of Additional Information. Further, all estimates and projections contained in the following information should not be construed as statements of fact. They are based on assumptions that may be affected by numerous factors and there can be no assurance that such estimates and projections will be realized or achieved.

General Economic Factors.

California’s economy, the largest among the 50 states and one of the largest and most diverse in the world, has major components in high technology, trade, entertainment, agriculture, manufacturing, government, tourism, construction and services. The relative proportion of the various components of the California economy closely resembles the make-up of the national economy.

In the May Revision of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget (as defined below), released May 14, 2010 (the “2010-11 May Revision”), the California Department of Finance (the “Department of Finance”) reported that the California economy started to recover from the recession in the latter part of 2009, but projected that growth in calendar year 2010 and beyond would be slow and would continue to lag slightly behind the national economic recovery as a whole. As of May 2010, unemployment in the State was 12.4%, compared to 12.5% in January 2010 and 9.7% in January 2009. The United States unemployment rate for May 2010 was 9.7%.

Current Financial Stress.

The State experienced a severe economic recession that began in the first quarter of 2008 and ended at some point in the second half of 2009. Personal income fell in the first three quarters of 2009 before increasing moderately in the fourth quarter of 2009. Taxable sales fell sharply in the first half of 2009 before increasing

 

D-1


Table of Contents

substantially in the fourth quarter of 2009 and the first quarter of 2010. The State’s unemployment rate increased from 5.9% in January 2008 to 12.4% in May 2010. The rate of increase has slowed in 2010. There can be no assurances that the fiscal stress and cash pressures currently facing the State will not continue or become more difficult, or that continuing declines in State tax receipts or other impacts of the current economic situation will not further materially adversely affect the financial condition of the State.

In response to the most severe economic downturn in the United States since the Great Depression, in the State’s budget plan for fiscal year 2009-10 adopted on February 20, 2009, as amended by the revisions enacted on July 28, 2009, together with other related budget legislation (the “Amended 2009 Budget Act”), the State implemented substantial spending reductions, program eliminations, revenue increases, and other solutions in order to close an estimated $60 billion budget gap over the combined 2008-09 and 2009-10 fiscal years. The State adopted reforms in nearly every area of government to better contain costs in the future. The 2010-11 May Revision included further reductions to many programs. If these proposals are adopted, it would bring overall General Fund spending to a level well below what it was a decade ago in fiscal year 1998-99 adjusted for population and inflation growth.

The State is slowly emerging from the recession, but economic growth is modest and the level of unemployment is still very high. Consequently, baseline General Fund revenues in fiscal year 2009-10 (consisting of total revenues adjusted to remove temporary tax law changes and one-time receipts) are projected to fall by more than 20% from their peak in fiscal year 2007-08. Major components of the revenue decline are capital gains taxes ($8 billion below peak levels), income tax on wages (approximately $6 billion below peak levels), tax on other types of income ($7 billion below peak levels), sales taxes ($10 billion below peak levels), corporate taxes ($2 billion below peak levels), and all other taxes (approximately $1 billion below peak levels). Consumer spending driven by easy credit and growth in home values is also not likely to return to prior levels in the foreseeable future. Future revenues will also be affected by the expiration of temporary tax increases enacted in fiscal year 2009-10.

In January 2010, California’s projected budget gap for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 was $19.9 billion. The deterioration of the State’s fiscal condition since adoption of the Amended 2009 Budget Act was due to a combination of lower than projected revenues, failure to achieve expected savings (due in part to adverse court decisions), and population and caseload growth. A special session of the California Legislature in February 2010 enacted several bills that addressed approximately $2.1 billion of this gap. Further reduced revenue estimates ($0.6 billion) and higher expenditure estimates ($0.7 billion) added approximately $1.3 billion to the gap, so that the 2010-11 May Revision projected the remaining budget gap at $19.1 billion. This figure is comprised of a fiscal year 2009-10 shortfall of $7.7 billion, a fiscal year 2010-11 shortfall of $10.2 billion, and a $1.2 billion reserve for fiscal year 2010-11.

The 2010-11 May Revision proposed additional solutions to close the remaining budget gap. Additional federal funds (over and above the $2.2 billion already approved) account for $3.4 billion in solutions, a reduction from the $6.9 billion of additional federal funds contained in Governor’s Proposed Budget for the 2010-11 fiscal year released on January 8, 2010 (the “2010-11 Governor’s Budget”). Spending reductions account for $12.4 billion in solutions. Additional solutions include $1.3 billion in alternative funding and $2.1 billion in fund shifts and other revenues. In response, California Legislative leaders have proposed two different budget plans, one of which calls for significant tax increases, and another that would rely on a borrowing plan using certain significant non-General Fund revenues. All such proposals are now being considered by the California Legislature. Even if all the Governor’s proposals were to be adopted, the Administration still projects that there will be multi-billion dollar budget gaps in future years, as temporary fiscal measures adopted in recent years have to be repaid or temporary tax increases expire.

The sharp drop in revenues over the last two fiscal years also resulted in a significant depletion of cash resources to pay the State’s obligations. For a period of one month, in February 2009, the State deferred making certain payments from the General Fund in order to conserve cash resources for high priority obligations, such as

 

D-2


Table of Contents

education and debt service. By July 2009, as new budget gaps were identified and with the failure to adopt corrective actions, the State’s cash resources had dwindled so far that, commencing July 2, 2009, the State Controller began to issue registered warrants (or “IOUs”) for certain lower priority obligations in lieu of warrants (checks), which registered warrants could not be immediately cashed. The registered warrants, the issuance of which did not require the consent of the recipients thereof, bore interest. The registered warrants were all called for redemption on September 4, 2009, once the State was able to access the public credit markets for cash management purposes following enactment of the Amended 2009 Budget Act. No registered warrants were used to make high-priority payments, including debt service on bonds, payments to schools, or employee payrolls. The issuance of State registered warrants in 2009 was only the second time the State has issued State registered warrants since the 1930s.

The 2010-11 May Revision projected that the State would have sufficient cash resources to pay all of its obligations through the end of fiscal year 2009-10, including repayment of all outstanding revenue anticipation notes in June 2010 (a first maturity of $2.825 billion was paid on May 25, 2010). Legislation enacted during the fiscal emergency special session of the California Legislature in early March 2010 will provide the State with additional tools to manage cash in the summer of 2010 and during key months of the budget year by authorizing short-term deferral of certain State payments, primarily to schools and local governments. Proposals to close the budget shortfall will substantially reduce this cash gap. In addition to budget solutions, the State will need to obtain external financing early in fiscal year 2010-11. At the Governor’s direction, the Department of Finance has begun working with the State Controller’s Office and the State Treasurer’s Office to develop additional cash solutions as needed to meet the State’s payment obligations.

The national and California economies improved between the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget and the 2010-11 May Revision. Output of the national economy grew for the third consecutive quarter in the first quarter of 2010, and California payroll employment grew in four of the six consecutive months ending in March 2010. However, some sectors of both economies have yet to show any positive signs – construction being a prime example.

There are signs that home prices have begun to stabilize and have improved in many regions of the State. Existing home sales peaked during the summer of 2005 and fell steadily through November 2008. A robust recovery in sales took place between November 2008 and November 2009, as sales were boosted by the first-time homebuyers’ tax credit. The tax credit was initially set to expire at the end of November 2009, but, prior to its expiration, it was extended through April 30, 2010. Following the tax credit’s extension, there was a moderate rebound in sales in March 2010. The tax credit’s expiration on April 30, 2010, coupled with severe winter weather, caused home sales to fall again.

The longest and deepest recession in the post-Depression era is most likely over. Both the State and national economies appear poised to make modest comebacks, and many indicators released since the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget forecast have been more encouraging than originally expected. Still, the recovery will probably be moderate and prolonged by historical standards.

The pension funds managed by the State’s principal retirement systems, the California Public Employees’ Retirement System and the California State Teachers’ Retirement System, have sustained significant investment losses during the economic downturn and currently have substantial unfunded liabilities that will require increased contributions from the General Fund in future years. The State also has an unfunded liability relating to retirees’ post-employment healthcare benefits that was estimated to be $51.8 billion as of June 30, 2009.

Recent Developments.

On May 14, 2010, the Governor released the 2010-11 May Revision. The 2010-11 May Revision disclosed that General Fund revenues in April 2010 were approximately $3.6 billion lower than projected in the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget, reversing three consecutive months of revenue results that exceeded forecasts. The majority

 

D-3


Table of Contents

of the shortfall was in personal income tax receipts and occurred for several reasons. First, extraordinary amounts of 2008 capital losses were carried forward into the 2009 tax year. Second, small business owners had less income in 2009 than had been projected at the time of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget. Lastly, in response to tax law changes, it appears that many quarterly filers paid a greater percentage of their estimated payments prior to April 2010 than was predicted at the time of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget, thus reducing final payments in April 2010.

On May 4, 2010, a California Superior Court judge ruled in favor of the State in the case of California Redevelopment Association et al. v. Genest et al. This ruling upheld a provision in the Amended 2009 Budget Act that required redevelopment agencies around the State to transfer $1.7 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $350 million in fiscal year 2010-11 to support public school funding within their jurisdictions (thereby relieving the General Fund from an equal amount of payments under Proposition 98). The decision has been appealed by the redevelopment agencies; however, substantially all of the transfers have been made.

On May 19, 2010, a lawsuit was filed on behalf of individual students, school districts, and educational organizations against the State (Robles-Wong et al. v. State of California) alleging that the State’s system of financing public schools is inconsistent with the mandate of the State Constitution to support public education. The suit seeks a declaration that the current system of school financing is unconstitutional and orders for the California Legislature and Governor to devise an adequate system of school financing.

On June 9, 2010, the California Supreme Court granted review of the Court of Appeal decision upholding the Governor’s vetoes of spending in the Amended 2009 Budget Act. There is no time yet set for hearing or decision in this case but the California Supreme Court set an accelerated briefing schedule with all briefings due by July 14, 2010.

On June 14, 2010, the United States Supreme Court granted the State’s petition for review of the decision by a three-judge federal court which ordered a reduction of the State prison population. It is expected that the case will be heard and decided during the United States Supreme Court’s 2010-11 term.

A number of initiative petitions have been filed with the California Secretary of State and will be placed on the November 2, 2010, election ballot. A number of the proposals would, if ultimately approved by the voters, impact State finances in various ways, as briefly summarized below.

 

   

Legalize sale of marijuana, which could produce increased State revenues if taxes are levied on such sales.

 

   

Raise the vehicle license fee by $18 annually and dedicate these funds to support State parks, reducing General Fund expenditures.

 

   

Restrict the ability of the State to use or borrow money from local governments and moneys dedicated to transportation financing.

 

   

Reduce the required vote in each house of the California Legislature to adopt the annual budget to a majority from two-thirds.

 

   

Repeal certain corporate tax breaks enacted as part of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, increasing future General Fund revenues.

On June 16, 2010, the California Public Employees’ Retirement System (“CaIPERS”) adopted a proposal that will increase the amount the State must contribute to CaIPERS for State employee pensions in fiscal year 2010-11. The State projects this will result in an increase in contributions of approximately $281 million, approximately 55% of which must be paid from the General Fund.

Subsequent to the 2010-11 May Revision, the Administration entered into tentative contract agreements with representatives of several bargaining units, representing more than 22,000 employees. These tentative

 

D-4


Table of Contents

agreements still require ratification by union members and the California Legislature. It is estimated that these contracts would save the State $72 million ($43 million General Fund savings) in fiscal year 2010-11.

Bond Ratings.

Three major credit rating agencies, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”), Standard and Poor’s Ratings Services (“S&P”), and Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”), assign ratings to California long-term general obligation bonds. The ratings of Moody’s, S&P, and Fitch represent their respective opinions as to the quality of the municipal bonds they rate. It should be emphasized, however, that ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality. Consequently, municipal bonds with the same maturity, coupon, and rating may have different yields while obligations with the same maturity and coupon with different ratings may have the same yield.

In April 2010, Fitch raised its rating assigned to California’s general obligation bonds from BBB to A-minus, and Moody’s raised its rating assigned to California’s general obligation bonds from Baa1 to A1. The changes in those ratings reflect a recalibration by Fitch and Moody’s, as applicable, of their United States municipal ratings from a municipal scale to a global scale, and neither change reflects a change in credit quality. In January 2010, S&P lowered its rating on California’s general obligation bonds from A to A-minus, indicating that the State’s “… severe fiscal imbalance and impending recurrence of a cash deficiency …” were factors in reaching its decision. It is not possible to determine whether or the extent to which Moody’s, S&P, or Fitch will change its respective rating on California general obligation bonds in the future.

California Finances.

General Fund. The moneys of the State are segregated into the General Fund and over 1,000 other funds, including special, bond, and trust funds. The General Fund consists of revenues received by the State Treasury and not required by law to be credited to any other fund, as well as earnings from the investment of State moneys not allocable to another fund. The General Fund is the principal operating fund for the majority of governmental activities and is the depository of most of the major revenue sources of the State. The General Fund may be expended as a consequence of appropriation measures enacted by the California Legislature and approved by the Governor (including the annual Budget Act, as defined herein), as well as appropriations pursuant to various constitutional authorizations and initiative statutes.

Special Fund for Economic Uncertainties. The State maintains a Special Fund for Economic Uncertainties (“SFEU”), which is funded with General Fund revenues and which was established to protect the State from unforeseen revenue reductions and/or unanticipated expenditure increases. The State Controller may transfer amounts in the SFEU to the General Fund as necessary to meet cash needs of the General Fund and such transfers are characterized as “loans.” The State Controller is required to return moneys so transferred without payment of interest as soon as there are sufficient moneys in the General Fund. At the end of each fiscal year, the State Controller is required to transfer from the SFEU to the General Fund any amount necessary to eliminate any deficit in the General Fund.

The legislation creating the SFEU (California Government Code Section 16418) also contains a continuous appropriation authorizing the State Controller to transfer the unencumbered balance in the General Fund to the SFEU, as of the end of each fiscal year. However, if, at the end of any fiscal year in which it has been determined that there are revenues in excess of the amount that may be appropriated, as defined in subdivision (a) of Section 2 of Article XIII B of the California Constitution, this transfer shall be reduced by the amount of the excess revenues. The estimates of the transfer shall be made jointly by the State’s Legislative Analyst’s Office (the “LAO”) and the Department of Finance. For budgeting and accounting purposes, any appropriation made from the SFEU, other than appropriations contained in California Government Code Section 16418, is deemed an appropriation from the General Fund. For year-end reporting purposes, the State Controller is required to add the balance in the SFEU to the balance in the General Fund so as to show the total moneys then available for General Fund purposes.

 

D-5


Table of Contents

 

Budget Stabilization Account. The Balanced Budget Amendment (“Proposition 58”), approved in March 2004, created the Budget Stabilization Account (the “BSA”) as a second budgetary reserve. Beginning with fiscal year 2006-07, a specified portion of estimated annual General Fund revenues (reaching a ceiling of 3% by fiscal year 2008-09) will be transferred by the State Controller into the BSA no later than September 30 of each fiscal year unless the transfer is suspended or reduced as described below. These transfers will continue until the balance in the BSA reaches $8 billion or 5% of the estimated General Fund revenues for that fiscal year, whichever is greater. The annual transfer requirement will go back into effect whenever the balance falls below the $8 billion or the 5% target. The annual transfers can be suspended or reduced for a fiscal year by an executive order issued by the Governor no later than June 1 of the preceding fiscal year. Proposition 58 also provides that one-half of the annual transfers shall be used to retire Economic Recovery Bonds (“ERBs”) of the State issued pursuant to the California Economic Recovery Bond Act (“Proposition 57”), until a total of $5 billion has been used for that purpose. A total of $1.495 billion of the $5 billion amount has now been applied to the retirement of ERBs. See “State Indebtedness – Economic Recovery Bonds” below.

The 2007, 2008, and 2009 Budget Acts give the Director of Finance the authority to transfer moneys from the BSA back into the General Fund in an amount determined by the Director of Finance to be sufficient to ensure there is a prudent General Fund balance. Using this authority, the Director of Finance ordered the transfer of the entire balance of $1.495 billion from the BSA to the General Fund to address a fiscal emergency proclaimed by the Governor on January 10, 2008. Once moneys are transferred out of the BSA, pursuant to the authority, they will not be replenished by a future fiscal year’s annual transfer unless the California Legislature, by statute, directs additional funds to be transferred from the General Fund into the BSA. Separate from the foregoing process for a budgetary transfer, the BSA may be used to make temporary loans to the General Fund, which must be repaid when the General Fund has available cash, as described under “Inter-Fund Borrowings” below.

In light of the condition of the General Fund, the Governor issued an Executive Order on May 28, 2008, suspending the fiscal year 2008-09 transfer of $3.018 billion from the General Fund to the BSA, as had been proposed in the Governor’s proposed budget for fiscal year 2008-09, released on January 10, 2008 (the “2008-09 Governor’s Budget”). Due to a drastic decline in General Fund revenues, the Governor issued an Executive Order on May 29, 2009, suspending the fiscal year 2009-10 transfer estimated at approximately $2.8 billion from the General Fund to the BSA. The 2010-11 May Revision retained the January 10 proposal to suspend the fiscal year 2010-11 transfer estimated at approximately $2.7 billion from the General Fund to the BSA. There are currently no moneys in the BSA.

Inter-Fund Borrowing. Inter-fund borrowing is used to meet temporary imbalances of receipts and disbursements in the General Fund. In the event the General Fund is or will be exhausted, the State Controller is required to notify the Governor and the Pooled Money Investment Board (“PMIB”) (comprised of the Director of Finance, the State Treasurer, and the State Controller). The Governor may then order the State Controller to direct the transfer of all or any part of the moneys not needed in Special Funds to the General Fund, as determined by the PMIB. All money so transferred must be returned to the special fund from which it was transferred as soon as there is sufficient money in the General Fund to do so. Transfers cannot be made which will interfere with the objective for which such special fund was created, or from certain specific funds. In general, when moneys transferred to the General Fund in any fiscal year from any special fund pursuant to the inter-fund borrowing mechanism exceed 10% of the total additions to such special fund as shown in the statement of operations of the preceding fiscal year as set forth in the Budgetary/Legal Basis Annual Report of the State Controller, interest must be paid on such excess at a rate determined by the PMIB to be the current earning rate of the Pooled Money Investment Account (“PMIA”). This provision does not apply to temporary borrowings from the BSA or other accounts within the General Fund.

The amount of loans from the SFEU, the BSA, and other internal sources to the General Fund as of the end of any month is displayed in the most recent State Controller’s Statement of General Fund Cash Receipts and Disbursements, on the first page under “Borrowable Resources – Outstanding Loans.” Copies of the State

 

D-6


Table of Contents

Controller’s monthly Statement of General Fund Cash Receipts and Disbursements are available at the State Controller’s website. Neither the State Controller’s website, nor any of the information contained therein, is incorporated herein by this reference and no representation is made as to the accuracy of the information contained therein.

Any determination of whether a proposed borrowing from one of the Special Funds is permissible must be made with regard to the facts and circumstances existing at the time of the proposed borrowing. The State Attorney General has identified certain criteria relevant to such a determination. For instance, amounts in the Special Funds eligible for inter-fund borrowings are legally available to be transferred to the General Fund if a reasonable estimate of expected General Fund revenues, based upon legislation already enacted, indicates that such transfers can be paid from the General Fund promptly if needed by the Special Funds or within a short period of time if not needed. In determining whether this requirement has been met, the Attorney General has stated that consideration may be given to the fact that General Fund revenues are projected to exceed expenditures entitled to a higher priority than payment of internal transfers, i.e., expenditures for the support of the public school system and public institutions of higher education.

At the November 1998 election, voters approved Proposition 2. This proposition requires the General Fund to repay loans made from certain transportation special accounts (such as the State Highway Account) at least once per fiscal year, or up to 30 days after adoption of the annual Budget Act. Since the General Fund may re-borrow from the transportation accounts any time after the annual repayment is made, the proposition does not have any adverse impact on the State’s cash flow.

In connection with the adoption of the 2008 Budget Act, statutory changes sponsored by the Administration were enacted to clarify 18 existing State funds as borrowable resources for General Fund cash flow purposes. These funds increased the total amount of borrowable resources by approximately $3.5 billion as of September 2008. An additional $500 million of additional borrowable resources were previously made available in August 2008 as a result of administrative actions taken by the State Controller.

The February 2009 Budget Act also included clarification of an additional 19 funds as borrowable resources for General Fund cash flow purposes. These funds provide approximately $2 billion of additional borrowable cash to the General Fund.

In addition to temporary inter-fund cash flow borrowings described in this section, budgets enacted in the current and past fiscal years have included other budgetary transfers and long-term loans from special funds to the General Fund. In some cases, such budgetary loans and transfers have the effect of reducing internal borrowable resources.

The California Budget.

The Budget Process. California’s fiscal year begins on July 1 and ends on June 30 of the following year. The State’s General Fund budget operates on a legal basis, generally using a modified accrual system of accounting for its General Fund, with revenues credited in the period in which they are measurable and available and expenditures debited in the period in which the corresponding liabilities are incurred.

The California Constitution specifies that an annual budget shall be proposed by the Governor by January 10 of each year for the next fiscal year (the “Governor’s Budget”). Under State law, the annual proposed Governor’s Budget cannot provide for projected expenditures in excess of projected revenues for the ensuing fiscal year. State law also requires the Governor to update the Governor’s Budget projections and budgetary proposals by May 14 of each year (the “May Revision”). The May Revision is normally the basis for final negotiations between the Governor and Legislature to reach agreement on appropriations and other legislation to fund State government for the ensuing fiscal year (the “Budget Act”). The Budget Act must be approved by a two-thirds majority vote of each House of the California Legislature. As required by the Balanced Budget

 

D-7


Table of Contents

Amendment (“Proposition 58”), beginning with fiscal year 2004-05, the California Legislature may not pass a budget bill in which General Fund expenditures exceed estimated General Fund revenues and fund balances at the time of the passage and as set forth in the budget bill.

Under the State Constitution, money may be drawn from the State Treasury only through an appropriation made by law. The primary source of annual expenditure appropriations is the annual Budget Act as approved by the California Legislature and signed by the Governor. The Budget Act must be approved by a two-thirds majority vote of each House of the California Legislature. The Governor may reduce or eliminate specific line items in the Budget Act or any other appropriations bill without vetoing the entire bill. Such individual line-item vetoes are subject to override by a two-thirds majority vote of each House of the California Legislature. An initiative Constitutional amendment will be included on the November 2, 2010, election ballot that would reduce the required vote to adopt a budget bill to majority from two-thirds.

Appropriations also may be included in legislation other than the Budget Act. Except as noted in the previous paragraph and in the next sentence, bills containing General Fund appropriations must be approved by a two-thirds majority vote in each House of the California Legislature and be signed by the Governor. Bills containing appropriations for K-12 schools or community colleges (“K-14 education”) require only a simple majority vote. Continuing appropriations, available without regard to fiscal year, may also be provided by statute or the State Constitution.

Funds necessary to meet an appropriation are not required to be in the State Treasury at the time an appropriation is enacted; revenues may be appropriated in anticipation of their receipt.

Constraints on the Budget Process. Over the years, a number of laws and constitutional amendments have been enacted, often through voter initiatives, which have increased the difficulty of raising State taxes, restricted the use of the General Fund or special fund revenues, or otherwise limited the California Legislature and the Governor’s discretion in enacting budgets. Historic examples of provisions that make it more difficult to raise taxes include Proposition 13, passed in 1978, which, among other things, required that any change in State taxes enacted for the purpose of increasing revenues collected pursuant thereto, whether by increased rates or changes in computation, be approved by a two-thirds vote in each House of the California Legislature. Examples of provisions restricting the use of General Fund revenues are Proposition 98, passed in 1988, which mandates that a minimum amount of General Fund revenues be spent on local education, and Proposition 10, passed in 1998, which raised taxes on tobacco products and mandated how the additional revenues would be expended.

Recent Constitutional amendments approved by the voters have also affected the budget process. These include Proposition 58, approved in 2004, which requires the adoption of a balanced budget and restricts future borrowing to cover budget deficits; Proposition 49, approved in 2002, which requires the expansion of funding for before and after school programs; Proposition 63, approved in 2004, which imposes a surcharge on taxable income of more than $1 million and earmarks this funding for expanded mental heath services; Proposition 1A, approved in 2004, which limits the California Legislature’s power over local revenue sources; and Proposition 1A, approved in 2006, which limits the California Legislature’s ability to use sales taxes on motor vehicle fuels for any purpose other than transportation.

The 2009-10 Budget. The State’s budget for fiscal year 2009-10 was enacted in an unusual sequence. The 2008 Budget Act was one of the latest ever enacted, having been delayed until mid-September 2008 as a result of the difficulty of balancing the budget with reduced revenues, as declining economic conditions were already evident. The 2008 Budget Act, however, was based on revenue assumptions made in the spring of 2008, which proved to be greatly overstated by the time actual revenue results for September and October 2008 were received. With the financial market meltdown starting in September 2008, which resulted in massive federal assistance and caused large drops in stock market and other asset values and reductions in consumer spending, projections of tax revenues, which are heavily dependent on capital gains taxes and sales taxes, had to be dramatically reduced. In November 2008, the Governor announced that the 2008 Budget Act would be billions of dollars out of balance, and called several special sessions of the California Legislature to enact corrective actions.

 

D-8


Table of Contents

 

Because of strong disagreement in the California Legislature as to the amount of corrective actions that would be taken by tax increases versus expenditure reductions, a compromise was not reached until February 2009. At that time, the February 2009 Budget Package was enacted which included modifications to the 2008 Budget Act and the enactment, more than four months early, of a full budget act for fiscal year 2009-10.

Initial 2009 Budget Act. The Initial 2009 Budget Act was adopted by the California Legislature on February 19, 2009, along with a number of implementing measures, and signed by the Governor on February 20, 2009. In February 2009, the State enacted $36 billion in solutions to what was then estimated to be a $42 billion General Fund budget gap for the combined 2008-09 and 2009-10 fiscal years. It also provided for five budget-related measures that would have provided an estimated $6 billion in additional budget solutions, to be placed before the voters on May 19, 2009. These measures were all rejected by the voters.

Under the Initial 2009 Budget Act, based on then-current assumptions about the State’s financial circumstances, and assuming receipt of approximately $8.0 billion of federal stimulus funds to offset General Fund costs ($4.9 billion of which was assumed to be received in fiscal year 2009-10) and voter approval of various ballot measures, General Fund revenues and transfers were projected to increase 9.3%, from $89.4 billion in fiscal year 2008-09 to $97.7 billion in fiscal year 2009-10. The Initial 2009 Budget Act contained General Fund appropriations of $92.2 billion, compared to $94.1 billion in fiscal year 2008-09, a 2.0% decrease. The June 30, 2010, total reserve was projected to be $2.1 billion, an increase of $5.5 billion compared to the estimated June 30, 2009, reserve deficit of negative $3.4 billion. The Amended 2009 Budget Act reflected vetoes by the Governor of $1.305 billion in appropriations from the General Fund, special funds, and bond funds (including $957.2 million in General Fund appropriations).

After adoption of the Initial 2009 Budget Act, the State continued to experience significant declines in revenues and other financial pressures. On May 14, 2009, the Governor released the May Revision of the Initial 2009 Budget Act (as subsequently updated, “2009-10 May Revision”). Together with subsequent revisions, the 2009-10 May Revision identified a further budget shortfall through the 2009-10 fiscal year of approximately $24 billion.

Amended 2009 Budget Act. On July 24, 2009, the California Legislature approved the amendments to the Initial 2009 Budget Act and the Governor signed the Amended 2009 Budget Act on July 28, 2009. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included another $24 billion in solutions to address the further deterioration of the State’s fiscal situation identified in the 2009-10 May Revision. Under the Amended 2009 Budget Act, General Fund revenues and transfers were projected to increase 6.4%, from a revised $84.1 billion in fiscal year 2008-09 to $89.5 billion in fiscal year 2009-10. A significant element of this increase was projected to come from certain new revenues enacted in February 2008. See “New Revenues” below. The Amended 2009 Budget Act contained General Fund appropriations of $84.6 billion in fiscal year 2009-10, compared to $91.5 billion in fiscal year 2008-09, a 7.5% decrease. The June 30, 2010, total reserve was projected to be $500 million as compared to the revised June 30, 2009, reserve of negative $4.5 billion. Subsequent events after adoption of the Amended 2009 Budget Act exceeded the reserve such that the Administration, as of May 2010, projected that fiscal year 2009-10 would end with a negative balance of $6.8 billion at June 30, 2010. The discussion below describes some of the elements of the Amended 2009 Budget Act that could not be implemented as originally expected.

The Amended 2009 Budget Act contained the following major General Fund components:

1. Addressing the Deficit. The $60 billion in budget solutions adopted for the combined fiscal years 2008-09 and 2009-10 ($36 billion in solutions were adopted in February 2009 and $24 billion in July 2009) were wide-ranging and touched all three of the State’s major revenue sources (personal income taxes, corporation taxes, and sales and use taxes). Spending cuts were implemented in virtually every State program that receives General Fund support. The budget solutions included spending reductions of $31.0 billion (52% of total solutions). The spending reductions consisted primarily of reductions in education spending under Proposition 98 ($14.9 billion reduction), higher education ($3.3 billion reduction), employee compensation ($2.0 billion reduction), and reductions in other spending due to the use of redevelopment agency revenues and fund balances to pay costs that

 

D-9


Table of Contents

would otherwise be payable from the General Fund ($1.7 billion reduction). The budget solutions also included an estimated receipt of $8.0 billion (13% of total solutions) of federal stimulus funds to be used to offset General Fund expenditures. Additional solutions included $12.5 billion of tax increases (21% of total solutions), and $8.4 billion of other solutions (14% of total solutions). Significant elements of the budget solutions include:

 

   

Proposition 1A of 2004 Borrowing from Local Governments. The Amended 2009 Budget Act authorized the State to exercise its borrowing authority under Proposition 1A, approved in the November 2004 election (“Proposition 1A of 2004”) to borrow from local agencies up to 8% of their fiscal year 2008-09 property tax revenues. The State utilized this authority and the borrowing generated $1.998 billion that was used to offset General Fund costs for a variety of court, health, corrections, and K-12 programs. The borrowed sums must be repaid by the State, with interest, by June 15, 2013.

 

   

Redevelopment Agency Borrowing. The Amended 2009 Budget Act also contained a shift of $1.7 billion in local redevelopment agency funds to the State from current revenues and reserves in fiscal year 2009-10 and $350 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Under the Amended 2009 Budget Act, these revenues are ultimately shifted to schools that serve the redevelopment areas. An association of redevelopment agencies, and a group of counties, have filed separate suits to block this transfer that, if successful, could adversely affect the State’s financial condition. However, substantially all of the required transfers have been made. In May 2010, a trial court ruled in favor of the State in this challenge; the decision has been appealed. Subsequent to enactment of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, the California Legislature also passed clean-up legislation authorizing redevelopment agencies to borrow from prior-year balances in the low and moderate income housing funds to make the fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 payments.

 

   

Payroll Shift. One-time savings of $1.618 billion ($937.6 million General Fund) from shifting the payments for employee payroll covering the pay period ending June 30, 2010, to July for all entities that are paid through the Uniform State Payroll System. This shift will be repeated on an annual basis. This payment shift excludes the University of California, Community Colleges, staff of the California Legislature, the California Exposition and State Fair, and local trial courts.

 

   

State Compensation Insurance Fund Sale. One-time revenues of $1 billion from the sale of certain assets of the State Compensation Insurance Fund (“SCIF”). Because of pending litigation, the State no longer expects the sale of SCIF assets to occur in fiscal years 2009-10 or 2010-11.

2. Federal Stimulus. The Amended 2009 Budget Act assumed the receipt of at least $8 billion from the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (“ARRA”) to offset General Fund expenditures in fiscal years 2008-09 and 2009-10. Final estimates put this amount at approximately $8.7 billion. As of May 19, 2010, approximately $7.8 billion has been received by the State, and the remainder is expected by the end of June 2010.

3. Cash Flow Management. The deterioration of revenues resulted in a cash shortage in fiscal years 2008-09 and 2009-10. In order to manage cash flow and provide for timely payments of the State’s obligations, the Amended 2009 Budget Act included a number of cash solutions to better balance timing of receipts and disbursements. Further cash management solutions were adopted by the California Legislature as part of a special session in early 2010. The State expects to be able to meet its payment obligations in the final months of fiscal year 2009-10 through administrative actions.

4. Proposition 98. As of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, the minimum funding guarantee under Proposition 98 for K-14 education (the “Proposition 98 Guarantee”) for fiscal year 2009-10 was projected to be $50.4 billion, of which $35.0 billion was the General Fund portion. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, the Proposition 98 Guarantee for fiscal year 2009-10 was projected to be $49.9 billion, of which $34.7 billion was the General Fund portion.

5. K-12 Education. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $66.7 billion for K-12 education programs for fiscal year 2009-10, of which $35.0 billion was funded from the General Fund. As of the Amended 2009 Budget

 

D-10


Table of Contents

Act, total per-pupil expenditures were projected to be $11,259 in fiscal year 2009-10. Revised estimates in the 2010-11 May Revision reflected $65.9 billion for K-12 education programs for fiscal 2009-10, of which $35.9 billion was funded from the General Fund. Revised estimates in the 2010-11 May Revision reflected that total per-pupil expenditures were projected to be $11,121 in fiscal year 2009-10.

6. Higher Education. The Amended 2009 Budget Act reflected total funding of $20.9 billion, including $12.5 billion General Fund and Proposition 98 sources, for all major segments of higher education (excluding infrastructure and stem cell research), including approximately $2 billion from local property taxes that are included in the Proposition 98 Guarantee and expended on California Community Colleges. The 2010-11 May Revision included total funding of $20.5 billion for fiscal year 2009-10, including $12.6 billion General Fund and Proposition 98 sources for all major segments of higher education (excluding infrastructure and stem cell research).

7. Health and Human Services. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $24.8 billion in non-Proposition 98 General Fund expenditures for health and human service programs for fiscal year 2009-10. Due to the State’s severe fiscal shortfall, the Amended 2009 Budget Act included $5.8 billion in proposed General Fund expenditure reductions in health and human services programs in fiscal year 2009-10. Apart from the reduction in General Fund funding for these programs, the Amended 2009 Budget Act reflected significant General Fund relief for Health and Human Services programs resulting from the ARRA. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, non-Proposition 98 General Fund expenditures for health and human service programs for fiscal year 2009-10 were projected to be $24.9 billion.

8. Transportation Funding. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $1.441 billion of General Fund expenditures to fully fund local transportation programs under Proposition 42 in fiscal year 2009-10. Additionally, the Amended 2009 Budget Act directed $1.015 billion of funds from sales tax on fuels to offset costs of programs otherwise likely to be funded from the General Fund such as debt service on transit bonds and other transportation programs. Of this amount, approximately $878 million was for uses substantially similar to those that were the subject of litigation related to the 2008 Budget Act. On September 30, 2009, the State Supreme Court denied review of an adverse Court of Appeal decision in Shaw v. Chiang, which invalidated the use of these funds as appropriated. Consequently, these fuels sales taxes were retained in the public transportation account for appropriation. These funds are “borrowable” for short-term General Fund cash needs. Chapters 11 and 12, Statutes of 2010, were passed in the special session providing General Fund relief by eliminating the State sales tax on gas and increasing the State gas excise tax by a like amount. This effectively eliminates funding subject to the provisions of Proposition 42 and significantly reduces the funding going into the public transportation account, eliminating the so-called spillover allocation. Fuel excise tax revenues will be used to offset highway bond debt service thus providing increasing General Fund relief beginning in fiscal year 2009-10 and growing in future years. (Approximately $603 million of relief is projected for fiscal year 2010-11.) Remaining public transportation account funds and new diesel sales tax revenues are used to offset transit bond debt service allowable under the court ruling in fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11. After these two fiscal years, the statute provides for no further use of public transportation account for debt service offset. Additionally, $650 million of excise tax proceeds available from this legislation in fiscal year 2010-11 is proposed to be lent to the General Fund. This funding is available without diminishing previously anticipated transportation program levels and will be repaid in three years.

The special session transportation legislation provides for ongoing highway and local road funding similar in distribution to the former provisions that governed Proposition 42 funds (sales tax on gasoline). Increased funding is provided for the State Highway Operations and Protection Program (highway safety and rehabilitation projects, primarily) as well as local streets and roads and the State Transportation Improvement Program (capacity projects, primarily). The legislation provides approximately $350 million in ongoing annual transit operations grants with a one-time appropriation of $400 million for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11. Two initiatives have been submitted for the November 2010 ballot that, if either is approved, limit the ability of the State to implement the transportation legislation.

 

D-11


Table of Contents

 

9. Budget Stabilization Account. Pursuant to Proposition 58, the State normally would be required to set aside a specified portion of estimated annual General Fund revenues for fiscal year 2009-10 in the BSA for reserves that may be used to offset future shortfalls in the General Fund. Given the magnitude and urgency of the State’s ongoing financial stress, in accordance with Proposition 58, the Amended 2009 Budget Act suspended the transfer to the BSA for fiscal year 2009-10.

10. Prison Funding. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $7.9 billion in General Fund expenditures for the California Department of Corrections and Rehabilitation (“CDCR”). In arriving at this figure, a total of $1.2 billion of savings for CDCR operations was assumed. Due to the delay in passage of legislation, and the failure of the California Legislature to adopt certain prison and parole reforms requested by the Governor, actual savings were approximately $587 million, with the result that CDCR costs were approximately $613 million higher than assumed in the Amended 2009 Budget Act, not including any changes as of the 2010-11 May Revision. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, CDCR costs in fiscal year 2009-10, excluding debt service and savings from employee compensation, were projected to exceed the level included in the Amended 2009 Budget Act by $906.6 million.

Fiscal Year 2009-10 Revised Estimates in the 2010-11 May Revision. The 2010-11 May Revision revised various revenue and expenditures estimates for fiscal year 2009-10. The 2010-11 May Revision projected, based on the various assumptions and proposals it contains, that the State would end fiscal year 2009-10 with a negative reserve of $6.8 billion, compared to the estimate of a negative $5.4 billion reserve at the time of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget.

The 2010-11 May Revision reflected a net increase of $493.1 million in the General Fund beginning balance at the start of fiscal year 2009-10, since the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget. This change in the starting balance is primarily due to the following components:

 

   

$317.4 million increase in fiscal year 2009-10 Corporate Income Tax accruals;

 

   

$184.1 million increase in fiscal year 2008-09 Proposition 98 savings.

As of the 2010-11 May Revision, General Fund revenues and transfers for fiscal year 2009-10 were projected at a revised $86.5 billion, a decrease of $1.563 billion compared with the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget estimates. This change is primarily made up of the following components:

 

   

$2.619 billion decrease in personal income tax;

 

   

$816 million increase in sales and use tax;

 

   

$240 million increase in other revenues and transfers.

Under the 2010-11 May Revision, General Fund expenditures for fiscal year 2009-10 were projected at $86.5 million, an increase of $373 million compared with the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget estimates. This increase in expenditures is primarily attributable to an increase in Proposition 98 expenditures of $1.2 billion, and a decrease in non-Proposition 98 expenditures of $803.3 million. The increase in Proposition 98 expenditures is primarily due to a decrease in Proposition 1A and redevelopment agency offset.

The non-Proposition 98 expenditure decrease is due primarily to the combined effects of an $814 million increase in health and human services expenditures, a decrease of $367.9 million in borrowing costs, increased federal funds offsets of $430.5 million, and an increase in Proposition 1A and redevelopment agency offsets of $890.2 million (previously budgeted as offset to Proposition 98 expenditures).

Budget Risks. The Amended 2009 Budget Act was based on a variety of assumptions. As described above, actual circumstances or conditions in fiscal year 2009-10 have differed from such assumptions in material respects, and the State’s financial condition may continue to be adversely impacted.

 

D-12


Table of Contents

 

As of June 13, 2010, budget risks still remaining for the 2009-10 fiscal year included, but were not limited to, the following:

 

   

Actual revenues through the end of fiscal year 2009-10 may be below projected amounts.

 

   

Delays in or inability of the State to implement budget solutions, or increased costs, as a result of litigation. The following cases dealing with elements of the Amended 2009 Budget Act are still pending:

 

   

There are almost three dozen separate cases dealing with the Governor’s furlough of State employees ($1.3 billion potential General Fund impact). The State Supreme Court has granted review of several cases, and several others are pending before the Court of Appeal. (In March 2010, the California Legislature passed legislation exempting from furlough State workers paid from sources other than the General Fund. The Governor vetoed this bill.); and

 

   

Potential court orders for the State to expend moneys for prison healthcare improvements, in excess of the amounts included in the Amended 2009 Budget Act.

Although appeals are continuing, the Governor has prevailed at lower court levels on several cases challenging aspects of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, including his vetoes of appropriations in July 2009 and the transfer of redevelopment agency moneys.

New Revenues. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included several major changes in General Fund revenues described below. The Amended 2009 Budget Act did not include any additional tax increases over those provided for pursuant to the Initial 2009 Budget Act, though it did include certain tax law changes intended to increase tax compliance and accelerate some revenues that were not in the Initial 2009 Budget Act.

As part of the Initial 2009 Budget Act passed in February 2009, the following tax and fee increases were adopted:

 

   

Temporary Sales Tax Increase. Effective April 1, 2009, the General Fund sales and use tax rate was temporarily increased by 1 cent, from 5% to 6% . This tax increase will be in effect through June 30, 2011. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this tax law change was expected to generate additional sales tax revenues of $4.299 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $4.223 billion in fiscal year 2010-11 for the General Fund.

 

   

Vehicle License Fees. Effective May 19, 2009, vehicle license fees were temporarily increased from 0.65% to 1.15% with 0.35% going to the General Fund and 0.15% going to the Local Safety and Protection Account for local law enforcement grant programs previously funded from the General Fund. Vehicle license fees apply to the value of the vehicle (initially its market value and then subject to a standard depreciation schedule). This increase will remain in effect through June 30, 2011. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this law change was expected to generate additional revenues of approximately $1.386 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $1.472 billion in fiscal year 2010-11.

 

   

Personal Income Tax Surcharge. The Initial 2009 Budget Act provided for a temporary addition of 0.25% to each personal income tax rate for tax years 2009 and 2010. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this change is expected to generate approximately $2.707 billion of additional General Fund revenues in fiscal year 2009-10 and $1.073 billion in fiscal year 2010-11.

 

   

Dependent Exemption Credit Reduction. The Initial 2009 Budget Act included a temporary reduction in the personal income tax-exemption credit for dependents to the amount provided for the personal credit for tax years 2009 and 2010 from $309 to $99 (tax year 2008 values). As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this change was expected to generate approximately $1.429 billion of additional General Fund revenues in fiscal year 2009-10 and $700 million in fiscal year 2010-11.

 

D-13


Table of Contents

 

The Amended 2009 Budget Act, passed in July 2009, included tax law changes affecting the General Fund as described below:

 

   

Non-Retailer Registration for Use Tax. Under current law in 2009, non-retailers – those who do not sell tangible personal property – were not required to register with the State Board of Equalization (“BOE”). This law change requires non-retailers that hold a business license and have at least $100,000 in gross receipts to register with the BOE and submit a return that details purchases made during the year that were subject to the use tax yet for which no use tax was paid. This law change was expected to increase General Fund sales and use tax revenue by $26 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $123 million in fiscal year 2010-11, with increasing amounts thereafter.

 

   

Accelerate Estimated Tax Payments. Under current law in 2009, individuals and corporations were required to pay 30% each with the first two estimated payments, and 20% each for the last two estimated payments. Under this law change, beginning with the 2010 tax year, the first quarter estimated payment percentage will remain at 30% payable on April 15, the second quarter will increase to 40% payable on June 15, the third estimated payment will be eliminated, and the fourth quarter estimated payment will increase from 20% to 30% payable on December 15 for corporations and January 15 for individuals. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this law change was expected to accelerate $1.295 billion into fiscal year 2009-10 ($672 million in personal income tax receipts and $623 million in corporate tax receipts) and $98 million in fiscal year 2010-11 ($60 million in personal income tax receipts and $38 million in corporate tax receipts).

 

   

Accelerate Wage Withholding. This tax law change increased current wage withholding rates by 10% and, as of the 2010-11 May Revision, was expected to accelerate $1.6 billion of personal income tax receipts into fiscal year 2009-10.

 

   

Require Backup Withholding. Under current federal law, gambling winnings reported on Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) Form W2G and payments made by banks and businesses reported on various IRS 1099 forms may be subject to backup withholding on those payments. Payments reported on IRS 1099 forms include payments to independent contractors, rents, commissions, and royalty payments. This law change conformed State law to federal law by requiring a withholding rate of 7% for State purposes whenever it is required for federal purposes. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this law change was expected to increase personal income tax revenues by $32 million in fiscal year 2009-10 followed by an additional $31 million in fiscal year 2010-11.

State Office Building Sales Program. Pursuant to legislation enacted in 2009, the State Department of General Services (“DGS”) has solicited proposals for the disposition of 11 State office properties, through a sale, lease, or a sale with an option to lease back. A large number of bids were received in April 2010 and the DGS is still conducting due diligence on the bids received. Once a preferred buyer has been identified, DGS will notify the California Legislature. Under current law, the California Legislature has 30 days to review the sales agreement, but a bill adopted unanimously by the Assembly on June 3, 2010 (AB 2605) would require affirmative California Legislative approval for the building sale to proceed. This bill is pending in the Senate. At this time, the amount of potential revenue from the proposed sale is unknown. The 2010-11 May Revision assumed approximately $600 million of one-time net revenues to the General Fund over the next three years from the sale. (Approximately $1.1 billion of other sale proceeds would have to retire existing debt used to construct some of the buildings.)

State Indebtedness.

The California Treasurer (the “Treasurer”) is responsible for the sale of debt obligations of the State and its various authorities and agencies. The State has always paid when due the principal of and interest on its general obligation bonds, general obligation commercial paper notes, lease revenue obligations, and short-term obligations, including revenue anticipation notes and revenue anticipation warrants.

 

D-14


Table of Contents

 

General Obligation Bonds. The State Constitution prohibits the creation of general obligation indebtedness of the State unless a bond measure is approved by a majority of the electorate voting at a general election or a direct primary. General obligation bond acts provide a continuing appropriation from the General Fund of all debt service payments on general obligation bonds, subject only to the prior application of moneys in the General Fund to the support of the public school system and public institutions of higher education. Under the State Constitution, the appropriation to pay debt service on the general obligation bonds cannot be repealed until the principal and interest on the bonds has been paid. Certain general obligation bond programs, called “self-liquidating bonds,” receive revenues from specified sources so that moneys from the General Fund are not expected to be needed to pay debt service, but the General Fund is liable as a back-up if the specified revenue source is not sufficient. The principal self-liquidating bond programs are the ERBs, supported by a special sales tax, and veterans general obligation bonds, supported by mortgage repayments from housing loans made to military veterans. General obligation bonds are typically authorized for infrastructure and other capital improvements at the State and local level. Pursuant to the State Constitution, general obligation bonds cannot be used to finance State budget deficits (except as already authorized by ERBs, as described below).

As of May 1, 2010, the State had outstanding $78,439,139,000 aggregate principal amount of long-term general obligation bonds, of which $68,917,429,000 were payable primarily from the General Fund, and $9,521,710,000 were “self-liquidating” bonds payable first from other special revenue funds. As of May 1, 2010, there were unused voter authorizations for the future issuance of $42,909,259,000 of long-term general obligation bonds, some of which may first be issued as commercial paper notes (see “General Obligation Commercial Paper Program” below). Of this unissued amount, $1,331,210,000 is for general obligation bonds payable first from other revenue sources.

Legislation enacted November 4, 2009, authorizes submission to the voters at the statewide election on November 2, 2010, of a ballot measure to approve the issuance of $11.14 billion in general obligation bonds for a wide variety of purposes relating to improvement of California’s water supply systems, drought relief, and groundwater protection. The bill specifies that not more than one-half of the bonds may be sold before July 1, 2015. Additional bond measures may be included on the November 2, 2010, election ballot.

Variable Rate General Obligation Bonds. The general obligation bond law permits the State to issue as variable rate indebtedness up to 20% of the aggregate amount of long-term general obligation bonds outstanding. As of May 1, 2010, the State had outstanding $5,294,440,000 principal amount of variable rate general obligation bonds (which includes a portion of the ERBs described below), representing approximately 6.7% of the State’s total outstanding general obligation bonds as of that date. Under State law, except for the ERBs, the State must pay the principal of any general obligation bonds that are subject to optional or mandatory tender, and that are not remarketed or, if applicable, purchased by financial institutions that provide liquidity support to the State. The State has not entered into any interest rate hedging contracts in relation to any of its variable rate general obligation bonds, and it no longer has any auction rate bonds outstanding.

General Obligation Commercial Paper Program. Pursuant to legislation enacted in 1995, voter-approved general obligation indebtedness may be issued either as long-term bonds or, for some but not all bond issues, as commercial paper notes. Commercial paper notes may be renewed or may be refunded by the issuance of long-term bonds. It is currently the State’s policy to use commercial paper notes to provide flexibility for bond programs, such as to provide interim funding of voter-approved projects and to facilitate refunding of variable rate bonds into fixed rate bonds. Prior to late 2008, commercial paper notes were used primarily to repay internal loans from the PMIA, as a step toward issuance of long-term bonds. However, the internal loan program is no longer being used for general obligation bond programs and all such loans have been repaid from sale of long-term general obligation bonds. Pursuant to the terms of the bank credit agreement presently in effect, the general obligation commercial paper program may have up to $2 billion in aggregate principal amount at any time. This maximum amount may be increased or decreased in the future. As of May 7, 2010, $1,292,170,000 aggregate principal amount of general obligation commercial paper notes were outstanding, most of which relates back to retirement of PMIA loan expenditures in 2008. Commercial paper notes are not included in the calculation of permitted variable rate indebtedness described under “Variable Rate General Obligation Bonds.”

 

D-15


Table of Contents

 

Bank Arrangements. In connection with the letters of credit or other credit facilities obtained by the State in connection with variable rate obligations and the commercial paper program, the State has entered into a number of reimbursement agreements or other credit agreements with a variety of financial institutions. These agreements include various representations and covenants of the State, and the terms (including interest rates and repayment schedules) by which the State would be required to repay any drawings (including drawings resulting from any failed remarketings) on the respective letters of credit or other credit enhancement to which such credit agreements relate. To the extent that any variable rate obligations cannot be remarketed over an extended period (whether due to reductions in the credit ratings of the institution providing credit enhancement or other factors), interest payable by the State pursuant to the reimbursement agreement or credit agreement would generally increase over current market levels relating to the variable rate obligations, and the principal repayment period would generally be shorter (typically less than five years) than the repayment period otherwise applicable to the variable rate obligation. On occasion the State’s variable rate obligations have not been remarketed resulting in draws on the applicable credit facilities.

During 2009, the State took a number of actions regarding its bank credit arrangements, including extending existing letter of credit facilities and converting standby purchase agreements to letters of credit for some of its floating rate ERBs and for its commercial paper program. The makeup of some of the State’s credit facilities was also revised with the deletion or substitution of banks. The State faces the need to renew approximately $1.37 billion of letters of credit for several series of variable rate general obligation bonds in November and December 2010.

Lease Revenue Obligations. In addition to general obligation bonds, the State has acquired and constructed capital facilities through the use of lease revenue borrowing (also referred to as lease-purchase borrowing). Under these arrangements, the State Public Works Board, another state or local agency, or a joint powers authority issued bonds to pay for the construction of facilities such as office buildings, university buildings, courthouses, or correctional institutions. These facilities are leased to a State agency, the California State University, the University of California, or the Judicial Council under a long-term lease that provides the source of payment of the debt service on the lease revenue bonds. In some cases, there was not a separate bond issue, but a trustee directly created certificates of participation in the State’s lease obligation, which were then marketed to investors. Under applicable court decisions, such lease arrangements do not constitute the creation of “indebtedness” within the meaning of the State Constitutional provisions that require voter approval. For purposes of this Statement of Additional Information, the terms “lease revenue obligation,” “lease revenue financing,” “lease-purchase obligation” or “lease-purchase” means, principally, bonds or certificates of participation for capital facilities where the lease payments providing the security are payable from the operating budget of the respective lessees, which are primarily, but not exclusively, derived from the General Fund, and also includes revenue bonds for a State energy efficiency program secured by payments made by various State agencies under energy service contracts. The State had $10,071,627,519 in lease revenue obligations outstanding as of May 1, 2010. The State Public Works Board, which is authorized to sell lease revenue bonds, had $9,834,701,000 authorized and unissued as of May 1, 2010.

Non-Recourse Debt. Certain State agencies and authorities issue revenue obligations for which the General Fund has no liability. Revenue bonds represent obligations payable from State revenue-producing enterprises and projects, which are not payable from the General Fund, and conduit obligations payable only from revenues paid by private users of facilities financed by the revenue bonds. The enterprises and projects include transportation projects, various public works projects, public and private educational facilities (including the California State University and University of California systems), housing, health facilities, and pollution control facilities. State agencies and authorities had approximately $56 billion aggregate principal amount of revenue bonds and notes, which are non-recourse to the General Fund outstanding as of December 31, 2009.

Build America Bonds. In February 2009, the United States Congress enacted certain new municipal bond provisions as part of the ARRA. One provision allows municipal issuers such as the State to issue “Build America Bonds” (“BABs”) for new infrastructure investments. BABs are bonds whose interest is subject to

 

D-16


Table of Contents

federal income tax, but the U.S. Treasury will repay to the State an amount equal to 35% of the interest cost on any BABs issued during 2009 and 2010. This results in a net interest expense lower than what the State would have had to pay for tax-exempt bonds of similar maturity. The subsidy payments from general obligation bonds are General Fund revenues to the State, while subsidy payments for lease revenue bonds are deposited into a fund that is made available to the State Public Works Board for any lawful purpose. In neither instance are the subsidy payments specifically pledged to repayment of the BABs to which they relate. The cash subsidy payment with respect to the BABs, to which the State is entitled, is treated by the IRS as a refund of a tax credit and such refund may be offset by the U.S. Department of the Treasury by any liability of the State payable to the federal government, including in respect of any internal revenue tax (including any interest and penalties), past due child support, past due and legally enforceable debt due federal agencies, unemployment compensation debts, and past due legally enforceable State income tax debts.

Starting in April 2009 and through April 30, 2010, the State has issued a significant amount of BABs, including $10.39 billion of general obligation bonds and $551 million of lease revenue bonds. The aggregate amount of the subsidy payments to be received from fiscal year 2010-11 through the maturity of these bonds (mostly 20 to 30 years) is approximately $7.46 billion for the general obligation BABs and $338 million for the lease revenue BABs. The Obama Administration has proposed making the BABs program permanent, although at a lower subsidy rate for future issuances. In late May 2010 the U.S. House of Representatives passed a bill (H.R. 4213) that extends the BABs program for two years at successively lower subsidy rates, but higher than those proposed by the Obama Administration; this proposal has not yet been acted on by the Senate.

Future Issuance Plans; General Fund Debt Ratio. Between November 2006 and August 2009, voters and the California Legislature authorized more than $60 billion of new general obligation bonds and lease revenue bonds. This new authorization substantially increased the current amount of such General Fund-supported debt outstanding to more than $79 billion, while still leaving authorized and unissued approximately $51 billion of such bonds as of May 1, 2010. In order to address the expenditure needs for these new authorizations, along with those that existed before 2006, the State has increased the volume of issuance of both of these categories of bonds substantially, compared to previous years, starting in fiscal year 2007-08. The amounts and timing of future issuance of general obligation and lease revenue bonds will depend on a variety of factors, including the actual timing of expenditure needs for the various programs for which such bonds are to be issued, the amount and timing of interim financing provided to the programs, the interest rate and other market conditions at the time of issuance, and the timing and amounts of additional general obligation bonds or lease revenue bonds that may be approved.

Disruptions in financial markets and uncertainties about the State’s budget condition caused significant disruptions in the State’s bond issuance program during fiscal year 2008-09. Because of these factors, the State did not issue any new general obligation bonds between July 2008 and March 2009. In March 2009, the State it issued $6.54 billion of new tax-exempt bonds, the largest new money general obligation bond issue in the State’s history (excluding ERBs). A few weeks later, the State took advantage of the new federal rules to issue $6.86 billion of federally taxable general obligations bonds, of which $5.3 billion were BABs. A significant part of the over $13 billion of bonds issued in the spring of 2009 was used to retire internal borrowings used to fund construction projects, which had built up because of the long hiatus in bond issuance. An additional $6.546 billion of tax-exempt and taxable general obligation bonds ($2.66 billion BABs) were issued in the fall of 2009, together with $1.549 billion of lease revenue bonds ($250 million BABs).

The combination of unusual circumstances resulted in public offerings of a record $19.7 billion of general obligation bonds during calendar year 2009. Through May 31, 2010, the State has issued $5.9 billion of general obligation bonds and $721 million of lease revenue bonds in calendar year 2010. The 2010-11 May Revision projected issuance of approximately $15.8 billion of general obligation and lease revenue bonds in that fiscal year. These are preliminary estimates, and the actual amount of bonds sold in fiscal year 2010-11 will depend on many factors, including more detailed review of program needs, budget priorities, and market conditions.

 

D-17


Table of Contents

 

Based on the current Department of Finance projections of program expenditure needs, without taking into account any future authorizations that may occur, the State Treasurer has estimated that the aggregate amount of outstanding debt supported by the General Fund, including general obligation, lease revenue, and Proposition 1A bonds, based on current voter and legislative authorizations, is estimated to peak at approximately $111.3 billion by fiscal year 2014-15, compared to the current outstanding amount of approximately $80.8 billion. The annual debt service costs on this amount of debt is estimated by the State Treasurer to increase to approximately $9.93 billion in fiscal year 2012-13 compared to approximately $6.09 billion budgeted in fiscal year 2009-10. The projected amounts for fiscal year 2010-11 through 2011-12 include the interest, and for fiscal year 2012-13, the interest and principal payable on the $1.90 billion of bonds issued in connection with Proposition 1A. After fiscal year 2012-13, projected peak debt service is $9.97 billion in fiscal year 2017-18. (These estimates do not include ERBs, described below, or veterans general obligation bonds supported by mortgage repayments from housing loans made to military veterans, nor do they take into account potential benefits from future refunding opportunities.)

In light of the substantial drop in General Fund revenues since fiscal year 2007-08, and the projections of substantial new bond sales in the future, the ratio of debt service on general obligation, lease revenue, and the Proposition 1A bonds supported by the General Fund, to annual General Fund revenues and transfers (the “General Fund Debt Ratio”) can be expected to increase significantly in future years. Based on the revised estimates contained in the 2010-11 May Revision, in fiscal year 2009-10, the General Fund Debt Ratio was estimated to equal approximately 7.03%. Based on the assumed debt issuance referred to in the preceding paragraph, and the assumed growth in General Fund revenues and transfers contained in the 2010-11 May Revision, through fiscal year 2013-14, the State’s General Fund Debt Ratio is projected to peak at 10.58% in fiscal year 2012-13, the year in which the Proposition 1A bonds mature. In the fiscal year following the maturity of the Proposition 1A bonds, fiscal year 2013-14, the State’s General Fund Debt Ratio is projected to decline to 9.34%. The State’s General Fund Debt Ratio after fiscal year 2013-14 will depend on the State’s future General Fund revenues, which will in turn depend on a variety of factors including but not limited to economic, population, and inflation growth. Based on the State’s current debt issuance projections and an assumed combined average annual General Fund revenue growth rate of between 2% to 5%, the State’s General Fund Debt Ratio in fiscal year 2019-20 is projected to range from 7.26% to 8.67%. The General Fund Debt Ratio is calculated based on actual gross debt service, without adjusting for receipts from the U.S. Treasury for the State’s current outstanding general obligation and lease revenue BABs, and an assumed interest rate of 6.25% and 6.75% for future issuances of general obligation and lease revenue bonds, respectively. The actual General Fund Debt Ratio in future fiscal years will depend on a variety of factors, including actual debt issuance (which may include additional issuance approved in the future by the California Legislature and, for general obligation bonds, the voters), actual interest rates, debt service structure, and actual General Fund revenues and transfers.

Economic Recovery Bonds. Proposition 57 was approved by the voters on March 2, 2004. Proposition 57 authorized the issuance of up to $15 billion in ERBs to finance the negative General Fund reserve balance as of June 30, 2004, and other General Fund obligations undertaken prior to June 30, 2004. Repayment of the ERBs is secured by a pledge of revenues from a one-quarter cent increase in the State’s sales and use tax that became effective July 1, 2004. In addition, as voter-approved general obligation bonds, the ERBs are secured by the State’s full faith and credit and payable from the General Fund in the event the dedicated sales and use tax revenue is insufficient to repay the bonds.

In May and June 2004, the State issued $10.896 billion principal amount of ERBs, resulting in the deposit of net proceeds to the General Fund of approximately $11.254 billion. In order to relieve cash flow and budgetary shortfalls identified in the 2008-09 Governor’s Budget, the State issued approximately $3.179 billion of additional ERBs on February 14, 2008, generating net proceeds of $3.313 billion, which were transferred to the General Fund. No further ERBs can be issued under Proposition 57, except for refunding bonds that may be issued in the future. (The Department of Finance had determined that the full $15 billion voter authorization could not be issued because of the previous repayment of certain June 30, 2004 obligations eligible for financing pursuant to Proposition 57.)

 

D-18


Table of Contents

 

Because of the sharp reduction in taxable sales as a result of the recent economic recession, the Special Sales Tax Revenues (“SSTRs”) collected from the one-quarter cent tax dedicated to repayment of the ERB debt decreased to a level that did not provide adequate coverage above the required debt service amounts for the 2004 and 2008 ERBs. This resulted in downgrades of the ratings of the ERBs and would have required debt service to be paid from reserve funds for at least some period of time. In order to restore adequate coverage, the State restructured the ERB debt through the issuance of approximately $3.435 billion ERB refunding bonds on November 5, 2009. The restructuring reduced annual debt service costs to come into alignment with reduced tax revenues, with a coverage target of at least 1.3 times. The ratings for all ERBs have been raised to levels above the State’s general obligation bond ratings.

Three different sources of funds are required to be applied to the early retirement (generally by purchase or redemption) of ERBs: (i) all proceeds from the dedicated quarter cent sales tax in excess of the amounts needed, on a semi-annual basis, to pay debt service and other required costs of the bonds, (ii) all proceeds from the sale of specified surplus State property, and (iii) 50% of each annual deposit, up to $5 billion in the aggregate, of deposits in the BSA. As of January 2010, funds from these sources have been used for early retirement of approximately $3.5 billion of bonds during fiscal years 2005-06 through 2009-10, including $1.495 billion that was transferred from the BSA in fiscal year 2006-07 ($472 million) and fiscal year 2007-08 ($1.023 billion). The State reported that approximately $122 million of surplus tax revenues will be used to retire ERBs on June 24, 2010.

The Governor suspended each of the fiscal years 2008-09, 2009-10, and 2010-11 BSA transfers due to the condition of the General Fund.

Tobacco Settlement Revenue Bonds. In 1998, the State signed a settlement agreement (the “Master Settlement Agreement” or “MSA”) with the four major cigarette manufacturers (the “participating manufacturers” or “PMs”). Under the MSA, the PMs agreed to make payments to the State in perpetuity, which payments at the time were predicted to total approximately $25 billion (subject to adjustments) over the first 25 years. Under a separate Memorandum of Understanding, half of the payments made by the cigarette manufacturers is paid to the State and half to local governments. The specific amount to be received by the State and local governments is subject to adjustment. Details in the MSA require reduction of the PMs’ payments for decreases in cigarette shipment volumes by the PMs, payments owed to certain “Previously Settled States” and certain other types of offsets. However, settlement payments are adjusted upward each year by at least 3% for inflation, compounded annually.

State law enacted in 2002 (the “Tobacco Securitization Law”) authorized the establishment of a special purpose trust to purchase the tobacco assets and to issue revenue bonds secured by the tobacco settlement revenues received beginning in the 2003-04 fiscal year. Legislation in 2003 amended the Tobacco Securitization Law to authorize a “back-up state guaranty” that requires the Governor to request an appropriation from the General Fund in the annual Budget Act to pay debt service and other related costs of the tobacco settlement revenue bonds secured by the second 2003 sale of tobacco settlement revenues when such tobacco settlement revenues are insufficient. The California Legislature is not obligated to make any General Fund appropriation.

In 2003, two separate sales of these assets financed with revenue bonds (the “2003 Bonds”) produced approximately $4.75 billion in proceeds, which were transferred to the General Fund. In 2005 and 2007, the State refunded all of the original 2003 Bonds, generating additional proceeds of approximately $1.783 billion, which were also transferred to the General Fund. The back-up State guaranty was applied to only the second 2003 sale of bonds and was continued when those bonds were refunded in 2005 (the “2005 Refunding Bonds”). The back-up State guaranty now applies to the $3.14 billion of 2005 Refunding Bonds.

The MSA provides for a potential reduction to the PMs’ payments under specified conditions relating to the loss of market share to non-participating manufacturers (“NPMs”). This potential reduction is called an “NPM adjustment.” The State disputes the PMs’ right to an NPM adjustment for any year. The MSA also allows the

 

D-19


Table of Contents

PMs to withhold any portion of their annual payments that is disputed, until such time as the dispute is resolved. Since 2006, the annual amount of revenues received by the State has incurred some level of withholding based on the PMs’ assertion of their right to receive an NPM adjustment as is reflected in the table below. Nevertheless, the annual amount of tobacco settlement revenues received to date has been in excess of the required debt service payments.

 

Year of Scheduled Payment

   Approximate NPM Adjustment Withheld  

2006

   $ 50.9 million   

2007

     44.0 million   

2008

     33.9 million

2009

     32.8 million   

2010

     35.3 million   

 

* In February 2009, these funds were released and remitted to the State as part of the NPM arbitration negotiations.

Source: State of California, Department of Finance.

The State Attorney General is pursuing, in a multi-state arbitration proceeding, a determination compelling the PMs to pay the full amount scheduled, given that the State asserts that it has been diligently enforcing the statute governing the NPMs, as required in the MSA.

Tobacco settlement revenue bonds are neither general nor legal obligations of the State or any of its political subdivisions and neither the faith and credit nor the taxing power nor any other assets or revenues of the State or of any political subdivision is or shall be pledged to the payment of any such bonds; provided that, in connection with the issuance of the 2005 Refunding Bonds, the State covenanted to request the California Legislature for a General Fund appropriation in the event tobacco settlement revenues fall short. Tobacco settlement revenues have been sufficient to pay debt service with respect to the tobacco settlement revenue bonds, and therefore the State’s covenant to request an appropriation has never been invoked.

Obligations In Connection with Proposition 1A of 2004. The Amended 2009 Budget Act provided for State borrowing, pursuant to Proposition 1A, of approximately $1.998 billion of local property tax revenues. In accordance with Proposition 1A, the State is required to repay such revenues no later than June 2013. Legislation implementing the borrowing in the Amended 2009 Budget Act provided authority to local governments to sell their right to receive the State repayment to a joint powers authority (JPA) and for the JPA to issue bonds backed by the State’s repayment obligation. The repayment obligation includes interest and issuance costs for the JPA bonds.

On November 19, 2009, the California Statewide Communities Development Authority, a JPA, issued $1,895,000,000 of bonds that are secured by the State’s obligation to make these payments to approximately 1,300 local governments, representing approximately 95% of the State’s total borrowing from local governments. The 2010-11 Governor’s Budget includes $90.8 million General Fund for the interest payments that will be incurred in that fiscal year. In accordance with the authorizing legislation, these bonds will be repaid by June 15, 2013. In addition, for the obligations to entities not participating in the JPA bond program (which are $103 million in principal amount), the Director of Finance has set an interest rate of 2% per annum.

 

D-20


Table of Contents

 

Cash Flow Borrowing. As part of its cash management program, the State has regularly issued short-term obligations to meet cash flow needs. The following table shows the amount of RANs issued in the past five fiscal years and through June 13, 2010, in fiscal year 2009-10:

State of California Revenue Anticipation Notes Issued

Fiscal Years 2004-05 to 2009-10

(Dollars in Billions)

 

Fiscal Year

    

Type

     Principal Amount       

Date of Issue

    

Maturity Date

2004-05

     Notes Series A - D      $ 6.0             October 6, 2004      June 30, 2005

2005-06

     Notes        3.0             November 10, 2005      June 30, 2006

2006-07

     Notes        1.5             October 3, 2006      June 29, 2007

2007-08

     Notes        7.0             November 1, 2007      June 30, 2008

2008-09

     Notes Series A-1        1.2             October 23, 2008      May 20, 2009
     Notes Series A-2        3.8             October 23, 2008      June 22, 2009
     Notes Series B-1        0.5             March 23, 2009      June 23, 2009

2009-10

     Interim Notes        1.5             August 27, 2009      October 5, 2009*
     Notes Series A-1        2.825         September 29, 2009      May 25, 2010
     Note Series A-2        5.975         September 29, 2009      June 23, 2010

 

* Repaid on September 29, 2009 with a portion of the 2009-10 Notes Series A.

Source: State of California, Office of the State Treasurer.

Indirect, Nonpublic, or Contingent Obligations.

 

   

Flood Litigation Judgment. In 2005, the State settled a lawsuit arising from liability for past flood damages through a stipulated judgment in the amount of $428 million, which provided for the State to make annual payments of $42.8 million, plus interest, for 10 years; the payments are subject to annual appropriation by the California Legislature. The California Legislature has included the required annual installment in each budget act since the settlement was approved. This matter is not treated as a “debt” of the State for any legal or constitutional purposes.

 

   

Unemployment Insurance Fund Borrowing. Commencing in January 2011, the State will be required to pay interest payments on loans made by the federal government to the State Unemployment Insurance (UI) Fund.

 

   

Special Fund Borrowings. As has been described in connection with various budget acts and current budget proposals, the General Fund has or may incur legal obligations to repay various Special Funds, or to repay schools or other local governments, for borrowings that have been treated as providing revenue to the General Fund. These loans may, in some cases, be further extended by the California Legislature. Such loans are not treated as “debt” for any legal or constitutional purposes.

 

   

Office of Statewide Health Planning and Development Guarantees. Pursuant to a law created in 1969, the Office of Statewide Health Planning and Development (“OSHPD”) insures loans and bond issues for construction and renovation projects for nonprofit and publicly-owned healthcare facilities. The program (commonly called “Cal-Mortgage Loan Insurance”) is currently authorized in statute to insure up to $3 billion for health facility projects. State law established the Health Facility Construction Loan Insurance Fund (“Fund”) as a trust fund that is continuously appropriated and may only be used for program purposes. The Fund is used as a depository of fees and insurance premiums and is the initial source of funds used to pay administrative costs of the program and shortfalls resulting from defaults by insured borrowers. If the Fund were unable to make payment on an insured loan or bond, State law provides for the State Treasurer to issue debentures to the holders of the defaulted loan or bond which are payable on a parity with State general obligation bonds. All claims on insured loans to date have

 

D-21


Table of Contents
 

been paid from the Fund. For the fiscal year ending June 30, 2009, OSHPD insured approximately 134 loans to nonprofit or publicly owned health facilities throughout California for approximately $1.7 billion. As of that date, the cash balance of the Fund was approximately $192.6 million. The OSHPD reported to the California Legislature that, as of June 30, 2009, the Fund balance was $95.0 million (unaudited). The Fund balance is determined by taking the cash balance, adding the value of assets (obligations due to the OSHPD for defaulted projects) and subtracting the liabilities (obligations of the OSHPD for defaulted projects). The OSHPD engaged Oliver Wyman to perform the 2008 actuarial study of the Fund, which concluded, among other things, that it appeared to be sufficient, assuming “normal and expected” conditions, to maintain a positive balance over 30 years. Even assuming abnormal and unexpected events, the study found that the Fund’s reserves would protect against General Fund losses for 14 years. More information on the program can be obtained from OSHPD’s website.

Sources of Tax Revenues.

In fiscal year 2008-09, approximately 90% of the State’s General Fund revenues and transfers were derived from personal income taxes, corporation taxes, and sales and use taxes. The following are brief summaries of the major sources of tax revenues in the State. The sections below captioned “Sales and Use Tax” and “Corporation Tax” include descriptions of pending lawsuits relating to various taxes.

Personal Income Tax. The California personal income tax, which accounted for 52.4% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2008-09, is closely modeled after the federal income tax law. It is imposed on net taxable income (gross income less exclusions and deductions), with rates ranging from 1% to 9.3%. For tax years 2009 and 2010, the rates will range from 1.25% to 9.55%. The personal income tax is adjusted annually by the change in the consumer price index to prevent taxpayers from being pushed into higher tax brackets without a real increase in income. Personal, dependent, and other credits are allowed against the gross tax liability. In addition, taxpayers may be subject to an alternative minimum tax (“AMT”), which is much like the federal AMT. The personal income tax structure is considered to be highly progressive. For example, the Franchise Tax Board indicates that the top 1% of taxpayers paid 43% of the total personal income tax in tax year 2008.

Proposition 63, approved by the voters in the November 2004 election, imposes a 1% surcharge on taxable income over $1 million in addition to the 9.3% rate (9.55% for tax years 2009 and 2010). The surcharge became effective January 1, 2005. The proceeds of the tax surcharge are required to be used to expand mental health programs.

Taxes on capital gains realizations, which are largely linked to stock market performance, can add a significant dimension of volatility to personal income tax receipts. Capital gains tax receipts accounted for 14.8% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2000-01. The 2010-11 May Revision projected that capital gains would account for 3.6% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2009-10 and 5.8% in fiscal year 2010-11.

Sales and Use Tax. The sales and use tax (referred to herein as the “sales tax”), which accounted for 28.7% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2008-09, is imposed upon retailers for the privilege of selling tangible personal property in California. Most retail sales and leases are subject to the tax. However, exemptions have been provided for certain essentials such as food for home consumption, prescription drugs, gas delivered through mains, and electricity. Other exemptions provide relief for a variety of sales ranging from custom computer software to aircraft.

The California use tax is imposed at the same rates as the regular sales tax on consumers of tangible personal property that is used, consumed, or stored in this State. Use tax applies to purchases from out-of-state vendors that are not required to collect tax on their sales. Use tax also applies to most leases of tangible personal property.

 

D-22


Table of Contents

 

As of May 1, 2010, the breakdown of the base State and local sales tax rate of 8.25% was as follows:

 

   

6% imposed as a State General Fund tax (this tax rate is scheduled to return to 5% on July 1, 2011);

 

   

0.5% dedicated to local governments for health and welfare program realignment (Local Revenue Fund);

 

   

0.5% dedicated to local governments for public safety services (Local Public Safety Fund);

 

   

1% local tax imposed under the Uniform Local Sales and Use Tax Law, with 0.25% dedicated to county transportation purposes and 0.75% for city and county general-purpose use; and

 

   

0.25% deposited into the Fiscal Recovery Fund to repay the State’s ERBs (the “special sales tax”).

Existing law provides that 0.25% of the base State and local sales tax rate may be suspended in any calendar year upon certification by the Director of Finance, by November 1 in the prior year, that both of the following have occurred: (1) the General Fund reserve (excluding the revenues derived from the 0.25% special sales tax) is expected to exceed 3% of revenues in that fiscal year (excluding the revenues derived from the 0.25% special sales tax) and (2) actual revenues for the period May 1 through September 30 equal or exceed the previous May Revision forecast. The 0.25% rate will be reinstated the following year if the Director of Finance subsequently determines conditions (1) or (2) above are not met for that fiscal year. The Department of Finance estimates that the reserve level will be insufficient to trigger a reduction for calendar year 2010.

Existing law provides that the special sales tax will be collected until the first day of the calendar quarter at least 90 days after the Director of Finance certifies that all ERBs and related obligations have been paid or retired or provision for their repayment has been made or enough sales taxes have been collected to pay all ERBs and related obligations to final maturity. At such time the special sales tax will terminate and the city and county portion of taxes under the uniform local sales and use tax will be automatically increased by 0.25%.

Proposition 1A, approved by the voters in the November 2004 election, amended the State Constitution to, among other things, reduce the California Legislature’s authority over local government revenue sources by restricting the State from lowering the local sales tax rate or changing the allocation of local sales tax revenues without meeting certain conditions. A proposed initiative constitutional amendment would restrict the ability of the State to use or borrow money from local governments, and moneys dedicated to transportation financing. See “Recent Developments” above.

An appellate court decision from 2008 held that two Dell entities and two providers of maintenance and warranty services had improperly collected from customers and remitted to the BOE use tax on optional service contracts that were sold with computers. The State anticipates that a pending action will result in a judgment or settlement requiring the BOE to refund the tax with interest. Plaintiffs estimate that the refund amounts could be as much as $250 million. Identification and notification of consumers affected by the decision and thus due a refund is unresolved, and determination of the total refund amount depends upon such identification and notification. The 2010-11 May Revision projected that the refunds will not occur prior to fiscal year 2011-12.

Corporation Tax. The corporation tax accounted for 11.5% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2008-09. Corporation tax revenues are derived from the following taxes:

1. The franchise tax and the corporate income tax are levied at an 8.84% rate on profits. The former is imposed on corporations for the privilege of doing business in California, while the latter is imposed on corporations that derive income from California sources but are not sufficiently present to be classified as doing business in the State.

2. Banks and other financial corporations are subject to the franchise tax plus an additional tax at the rate of 2% on their net income. This additional tax is in lieu of personal property taxes and business license taxes.

3. The AMT is similar to that in federal law. In general, the AMT is based on a higher level of net income computed by adding back certain tax preferences. This tax is imposed at a rate of 6.65%.

 

D-23


Table of Contents

 

4. A minimum franchise tax of up to $800 is imposed on corporations subject to the franchise tax but not on those subject to the corporate income tax. New corporations are exempted from the minimum franchise tax for the first year of incorporation.

5. Sub-Chapter S corporations are taxed at 1.5% of profits.

6. Fees paid by limited liability companies (“LLCs”), which account for 2.8% of corporation tax revenue, are considered “corporation taxes.” Three separate cases have been filed challenging the constitutionality of the LLC fee. Two have been resolved and one is pending. In California Taxpayers Association v. Franchise Tax Board, California Taxpayers Association (“Cal-Tax”), plaintiffs challenged the constitutionality of the corporate understatement penalty that was enacted in Chapter 1, Statutes of 2007-08 First Extraordinary Session (SB X1 28, 2008 Budget Act Trailer Bill) and sought an injunction precluding the Franchise Tax Board from enforcing the statute. The trial court ruled for the State and Cal-Tax appealed. A decision may be issued during fiscal year 2010-11. An adverse ruling would resulting a potential loss or revenue in fiscal year 2010-11 of between $500 million and $800 million, and an ongoing loss of approximately $500 million thereafter.

As part of the 2009 Budget Act, the California Legislature adopted certain additional tax benefits for corporations, affecting carryover of losses, sharing tax credits among affiliates, and changes to the unitary tax calculations for multinational corporations, all of which were to become effective in 2011 or later. An initiative statute will be included on the November 2010 ballot that would repeal all of these new tax benefits. It is estimated that such a repeal, if approved by the voters, would increase General Fund revenues by approximately $1.7 billion annually starting in fiscal year 2011-12.

Insurance Tax. The majority of insurance written in California is subject to a 2.35% gross premium tax. For insurers, this premium tax takes the place of all other State and local taxes except those on real property and motor vehicles. Exceptions to the 2.35% rate are certain pension and profit-sharing plans which are taxed at the lesser rate of 0.5%, surplus lines and non-admitted insurance at 3% and ocean marine insurers at 5% of underwriting profits. To provide interim funding for the Healthy Families and Medi-Cal programs, Chapter 157, Statutes of 2009 extends the 2.35% gross premiums tax to the Medi-Cal managed care plans in 2009 and 2010.

The BOE ruled in December 2006 that the premium tax insurers pay should be calculated on a cash basis rather than the accrual method required by the California Department of Insurance. This ruling is expected to result in a total loss of $406 million spread over several years; the impact was $15 million in fiscal year 2008-09 and is estimated to be $11 million in fiscal year 2009-10, $230 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and $149 million in fiscal year 2011-12.

Vehicle License Fee. The Amended 2009 Budget Act temporarily increased the vehicle license fee from 0.65% to 1.15%, effective May 19, 2009, through June 30, 2011. Of this 0.5% increase, 0.35% goes to the General Fund, with the remaining 0.15% going to local law enforcement. An initiative has been qualified for the November 2010 ballot that would increase the annual vehicle license fee by $18 and dedicate the revenue to support of State parks and wildlife conservation. This measure, if approved by the voters, would generate an estimated $500 million per year for parks and wildlife conservation programs, which would save an equivalent amount of General Fund expenditures.

Estate Tax; Other Taxes. The State estate tax is based on the State death tax credit allowed against the federal estate tax. The California estate tax is designed to pick up the maximum credit allowed against the federal estate tax return. The federal Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act of 2001 (the “Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act”) phases out the federal estate tax by 2010. As a consequence, the Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act resulted in the reduction of the State estate tax revenues by 25% in calendar year 2002, 50% in calendar year 2003, and 75% in calendar year 2004, and the elimination of the State estate tax beginning in calendar year 2005. The provisions of this federal act sunset after 2010. At that time, the federal estate tax is scheduled to be reinstated along with the State’s estate tax. Federal estate tax law may be changed to modify or eliminate the State pick-up tax.

 

D-24


Table of Contents

 

Other General Fund major taxes and licenses include: Inheritance and Gift Taxes; Cigarette Taxes; Alcoholic Beverage Taxes; Horse Racing License Fees, and Trailer Coach License Fees.

Special Fund Revenues. The California Constitution and statutes specify the uses of certain revenues. Such receipts are accounted for in various special funds. In general, special fund revenues comprise three categories of income:

 

   

Receipts from tax levies which are allocated to specified functions, such as motor vehicle taxes and fees and certain taxes on tobacco products.

 

   

Charges for special services to specific functions, including such items as business and professional license fees.

 

   

Rental royalties and other receipts designated for particular purposes (e.g., oil and gas royalties).

Motor vehicle related taxes and fees are projected to account for 39% of all special fund revenues in fiscal year 2010-11. Principal sources of this income are motor vehicle fuel taxes, registration and weight fees, and vehicle license fees. In fiscal year 2010-11, $10.9 billion is projected to come from the ownership or operation of motor vehicles. Approximately $2.9 billion of this revenue is projected to be returned to local governments. The remainder will be available for various State programs related to transportation and services to vehicle owners.

Taxes on Tobacco Products. As a result of Proposition 99, approved by the voters in 1988, and Proposition 10, approved by the voters in 1998, the State imposes an excise tax on cigarettes of 87 cents per pack and the equivalent rates on other tobacco products. Tobacco product excise tax revenues are earmarked as follows:

1. Fifty cents of the per-pack tax on cigarettes and the equivalent rate levied on non-cigarette tobacco products are deposited in the California Children and Families First Trust Fund and are allocated primarily for early childhood development programs.

2. Twenty-five cents of the per-pack tax on cigarettes and the equivalent rates levied on non-cigarette tobacco products are allocated to the Cigarette and Tobacco Products Surtax Fund. These funds are appropriated for anti-tobacco education and research, indigent health services, and environmental and recreation programs.

3. Ten cents of the per-pack tax is allocated to the State’s General Fund.

4. The remaining two cents of the per-pack tax is deposited into the Breast Cancer Fund.

The following table shows the trend of major General Fund and total taxes per capita and per $100 of personal income for the past five fiscal years and fiscal year 2010-11.

Recent Tax Receipts

 

       State Taxes per Capita(a)        Taxes per $100
of Personal Income
 

Fiscal Year

     General Fund        Total        General Fund        Total  

2005-06

       2,451.75           2,867.55           6.52           7.63   

2006-07

       2,501.35           2,934.28           6.23           7.31   

2007-08

       2,530.79           2,967.26           6.06           7.11   

2008-09

       2,084.46           2,494.59           4.95           5.92   

2009-10

       2,189.84           2,571.00           5.40           6.34   

2010-11 (budget)

       2,265.68           2,701.14           5.46           6.51   

 

* Data reflects population figures based on the 2000 Census – estimated.

Source: State of California, Department of Finance.

 

D-25


Table of Contents

 

State Appropriations Limit.

The State is subject to an annual appropriations limit imposed by Article XIIIB of the State Constitution (the “Appropriations Limit”). The Appropriations Limit does not restrict appropriations to pay debt service on voter-authorized bonds.

Article XIII B prohibits the State from spending “appropriations subject to limitation” in excess of the Appropriations Limit. “Appropriations subject to limitation,” with respect to the State, are authorizations to spend “proceeds of taxes,” which consist of tax revenues, and certain other funds, including proceeds from regulatory licenses, user charges or other fees to the extent such proceeds exceed “the cost reasonably borne by that entity in providing the regulation, product or service,” but “proceeds of taxes” exclude most State subventions to local governments, tax refunds, and some benefit payments such as unemployment insurance. No limit is imposed on appropriations of funds which are not “proceeds of taxes,” such as reasonable user charges or fees and certain other non-tax funds.

There are various types of appropriations excluded from the Appropriations Limit. For example, debt service costs of bonds existing or authorized by January 1, 1979, or subsequently authorized by the voters, appropriations required to comply with mandates of courts or the federal government, appropriations for qualified capital outlay projects, appropriations for tax refunds, appropriations of revenues derived from any increase in gasoline taxes and motor vehicle weight fees above January 1, 1990 levels, and appropriation of certain special taxes imposed by initiative (e.g., cigarette and tobacco taxes) are all excluded. The Appropriations Limit may also be exceeded in cases of emergency.

The Appropriations Limit in each year is based on the Appropriations Limit for the prior year, adjusted annually for changes in State per capita personal income and changes in population, and adjusted, when applicable, for any transfer of financial responsibility of providing services to or from another unit of government or any transfer of the financial source for the provisions of services from tax proceeds to non-tax proceeds. The measurement of change in population is a blended average of statewide overall population growth, and change in attendance at local school and community college (K-14) districts. The Appropriations Limit is tested over consecutive two-year periods. Any excess of the aggregate “proceeds of taxes” received over such two-year period above the combined Appropriations Limits for those two years, is divided equally between transfers to K-14 districts and refunds to taxpayers.

The California Legislature has enacted legislation to implement Article XIIIB which defines certain terms used in Article XIIIB and sets forth the methods for determining the Appropriations Limit. California Government Code Section 7912 requires an estimate of the Appropriations Limit to be included in the Governor’s Budget, and thereafter to be subject to the budget process and established in the Budget Act.

The following table shows the Appropriations Limit for fiscal years 2006-07 through 2010-11.

State Appropriations Limit

(Dollars in Millions)

 

     2006-07     2007-08     2008-09     2009-10     2010-11  

State Appropriations Limit

   $ 72,307      $ 76,093      $ 79,858      $ 80,984      $ 79,118   

Appropriations Subject to Limit

     (58,663     (59,201     (48,233     (57,849 )*      (58,424 )* 
                                        

Amount (Over)/Under Limit

   $ 13,641      $ 16,892      $ 31,625      $ 23,135   $ 20,694

 

* Estimated/projected.

Source: State of California, Department of Finance.

 

D-26


Table of Contents

 

Litigation.

The State is continually a party to numerous legal proceedings, many of which could have an adverse impact on the State’s financial condition. Pending litigation currently includes, but is not limited to, cases involving issues related to the budget, taxes, environmental matters, health care, tribal gaming, transportation, education, and the State’s prison system, all of which, if decided adversely to California, could result in significant General Fund expenditures or otherwise impact the ability of the State to raise revenues.

Local Governments.

The primary units of local government in California are the 58 counties, which range in population from approximately 1,100 in Alpine County to approximately 10.4 million in Los Angeles County. Counties are responsible for the provision of many basic services, including indigent health care, welfare, jails, and public safety in unincorporated areas. There are also 480 incorporated cities in California and thousands of special districts formed for education, utilities, and other services.

The fiscal condition of local governments was changed when Proposition 13, which added Article XIIIA to the State Constitution, was approved by California voters in 1978. Proposition 13 reduced and limited the future growth of property taxes and limited the ability of local governments to impose “special taxes” (those devoted to a specific purpose) without two-thirds voter approval. Although Proposition 13 limited property tax growth rates, it also has had a smoothing effect on property tax revenues, ensuring greater stability in annual revenues than existed before Proposition 13 passed.

Proposition 218, another constitutional amendment enacted by initiative in 1996, further limited the ability of local governments to raise taxes, fees, and other exactions. (The limitations include requiring a majority vote approval for general local tax increases, prohibiting fees for services in excess of the cost of providing such service, and providing that no fee may be charged for fire, police, or any other service widely available to the public.)

In the aftermath of Proposition 13, the State provided aid to local governments from the General Fund to make up some of the loss of property tax moneys, including assuming principal responsibility for funding K-12 schools and community colleges. During the recession of the early 1990s, the California Legislature reduced the post-Proposition 13 aid to local government entities other than K-12 schools and community colleges by requiring cities and counties to transfer some of their property tax revenues to school districts. However, the California Legislature also provided additional funding sources, such as sales taxes, and reduced certain mandates for local services funded by cities and counties.

The 2004 Budget Act, related legislation, and the enactment of Proposition 1A in 2004 dramatically changed the State-local fiscal relationship. These constitutional and statutory changes implemented an agreement negotiated between the Governor and local government officials (the “state-local agreement”) in connection with the 2004 Budget Act. One change relates to the reduction of the vehicle license fee (“VLF”) rate from 2% to 0.65% of the market value of the vehicle. In order to protect local governments, which had previously received all VLF revenues, the 1.35% reduction in VLF revenue to cities and counties from this rate change was backfilled (or offset) by an increase in the amount of property tax revenues they receive. This worked to the benefit of local governments because the backfill amount annually increases in proportion to the growth in property tax revenues, which has historically grown at a higher rate than VLF revenues, although property tax revenues have declined over the past two years. This arrangement continues without change in the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget.

Pursuant to statutory changes made in conjunction with the Initial 2009 Budget Act, the VLF rate increased from 0.65% to 1.15% effective May 19, 2009. Of this 0.50% increase, 0.35% flows to the General Fund, and 0.15% supports various law enforcement programs previously funded by the General Fund. This increased VLF rate will be effective through the 2010-11 fiscal year.

 

D-27


Table of Contents

 

As part of the state-local agreement, voters at the November 2004 election approved Proposition 1A. Proposition 1A amended the State Constitution to, among other things, reduce the California Legislature’s authority over local government revenue sources by placing restrictions on the State’s access to local governments’ property, sales, and VLF revenues as of November 3, 2004.

The Amended 2009 Budget Act authorized the State to exercise its authority under Proposition 1A to borrow an amount equal to approximately 8% of local property tax revenues, or $1.9 billion, which must be repaid within three years. State law was also enacted to create a securitization mechanism for local governments to sell their right to receive the State’s payment obligations to a local government-operated joint powers authority. This joint powers authority sold bonds in a principal amount of $1.895 billion in November 2009 to pay the participating local governments their full property tax allocations when they normally would receive such allocations. Pursuant to Proposition 1A, the State is required to repay the local government borrowing (which in turn will be used to repay the bonds of the joint powers authority) no later than June 30, 2013. The 2010-11 Governor’s Budget includes $90.8 million for the interest payments that will be incurred in that fiscal year to be paid from the General Fund.

The Amended 2009 Budget Act also contained a shift of $1.7 billion in redevelopment agency funds from current revenue and reserves in fiscal year 2009-10 and $350 million in fiscal year 2010-11. These revenues are shifted to schools that serve the redevelopment areas. This frees an equal amount of base property tax that is shifted to the Supplemental Education Revenue Augmentation Funds in each county that are established by Proposition 1A and used for the same purposes. The enabling legislation allows redevelopment agencies to borrow from parent agencies, and from any available reserves in their low and moderate income housing funds.

The California Redevelopment Association (“CRA”), whose membership includes a large number of redevelopment agencies, has filed a lawsuit challenging the $1.7 billion shift described above. The 2008 Budget Act included a shift of $350 million of redevelopment agency moneys. The CRA had also challenged that shift, and a trial court held that the legislation providing for the shift was invalid, which prevented the State from shifting the funds for the 2008-09 fiscal year. The State withdrew its appeal of the decision and subsequently enacted legislation that addresses the concerns noted by the trial court. However, the subsequently enacted legislation is being challenged in the current CRA lawsuit. A group of counties has filed a separate lawsuit challenging the shift. The Sacramento County Superior Court issued a ruling on May 4, 2010, upholding the State’s ability to shift $1.7 billion and $350 million from redevelopment agencies in fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11, respectively. The CRA has appealed the ruling.

Economic, Political, Social and Environmental Conditions.

Changes in economic, political, social or environmental conditions on a local, State, federal and/or international level may adversely affect California’s financial condition, as well as investment risk generally. Such conditional changes may include (but are not limited to) fluctuations in business production, consumer prices or financial markets, unemployment rates, technological advancements, shortages or surpluses in natural resources or energy supplies, changes in law, social unrest, fluctuations in the crime rate, political conflict, acts of war or terrorism, environmental damage and natural disasters.

Georgia

Located in the southeastern region of the United States, the State of Georgia (“Georgia” and the “State”) has experienced substantial growth over the last several decades. Since 1960, the population of Georgia has more than doubled, currently making Georgia the country’s ninth most populated state. Between 2000 and 2009, Georgia grew by an estimated 1,642,758 people, a growth rate of 20.1 percent, fourth fastest in the nation, and fastest east of the Mississippi River (2009 Census estimate: 9,829,211). From 2000 to 2009, 17 of Georgia’s counties ranked among the nation’s 100 fastest-growing, second most in the nation, including two counties (both located in metro Atlanta) which ranked among the top ten.

 

D-28


Table of Contents

 

This population increase is expected to continue for the foreseeable future at approximately the same accelerated rate. In its March 2010 report, the Governor’s Office of Planning and Budget estimated that Georgia’s population will increase by an additional 4.6 million people over the next 20 years, with over 60% of this growth attributable to people moving into the state. While the fastest-paced growth is expected in the northern and coastal areas of the state, it is expected that the Atlanta MSA will remain the most densely populated area, with approximately 43% of all Georgians living in this area.

Georgia’s economy is fairly diversified, with private sector employment almost equally spread between manufacturing, services, wholesale sales and retail sales, with concentrations in manufacturing, trade, transportation and utilities, information technology, and professional and business services. During the second half of the 20th century, this diversity allowed Georgia to experience almost continuous economic growth, while other states more dependent upon a single business sector experienced some periods of economic contraction. However, during the last several years, this diversity has been unable to fully insulate Georgia’s economy from the nationwide economic downturn that occurred in 2002-2004 and the current one which began in December 2007.

One area where this economic diversity, in combination with Georgia’s population growth, and its effects on the local economy can be seen is Georgia’s labor market. Historically, Georgia has enjoyed an unemployment rate significantly at or below the national average. Unfortunately, as of June 2010, the state’s unemployment rate stood at 10.0%, which is slightly above the national average of 9.5%.

While the raw numbers are not positive, the trend is favorable. The Georgia unemployment rate is down from a high of 10.5% in March 2010 (but still above a year earlier rate of 9.7%). Similarly, the Georgia total non-farm employment figures are up (3.83 million for June 2010 as opposed to a low of 3.78 million in February 2010), but they are still below year earlier figures (3.88 million). This trend is reflected in the May 2010 US Regional Recession Status by Moody’s Economy.com which classifies Georgia to be “moderating recession,” defined as the state’s economy not contracting as severely as six months earlier.

Historically, most of the job growth in Georgia has been in the Atlanta MSA. However, over the last several years, there has been great emphasis placed upon developing other parts of the State, so that these areas can begin to reap the economic benefits traditionally limited to the Atlanta MSA. One example of this is the OneGeorgia Authority, which is discussed below. Those efforts have begun to bear fruit, as for the last several years, the statewide growth rate has exceeded the Atlanta MSA growth rate. However, this trend has been muted over the past year, as the rate of job loss in the Atlanta MSA (1.0%) has been slightly lower than the rate for the balance of the state (1.3%).

One reason that Georgia has such a positive economic outlook is because of its location, which affords its residents and businesses easy access to commercial centers throughout the nation and the world. As business and consumer confidence grows, it is believed that centers of transportation and logistics will gain as inventories get restocked and goods are shipped. Evidence of this upswing has been observed at both Hartsfield-Jackson Airport and the Port of Savannah; while cargo traffic still remains below prior year levels, as discussed below both locations have Georgia experienced an uptick in cargo traffic over the last few months.

For ground transportation, the capital city of Atlanta is one of the few major US cities with 3 interstate highways. As a result, Georgia manufacturers and distributors are within 2 truckload days of 82% of the US industrial market. During an average week, about 5.9 million tons of freight move across Georgia’s highways. Furthermore, Georgia has the most extensive rail system and largest intermodal hub in the Southeast. Georgia also ranks as the 5th largest overall logistics employer in the nation with nearly 11,000 providers of logistics services.

Since 1998, Hartsfield-Jackson (the “Airport”) has been the busiest passenger airport in the world, serving over 88,032,086 passengers in 2009 through 32 carriers, with destinations to over 231 destinations in 52

 

D-29


Table of Contents

countries. Also, for the fifth consecutive year, the Airport retains its title as the nation’s busiest airport in terms of operations (takeoffs and landings) with 970,258 operations. Atlanta is within a two hour flight of 80% of the United States population. The current economic downturn has negatively impacted the Airport. In 2009 the number of domestic travelers fell 1.69% in one year, while international passengers fell by 3.79%. This downward trend is expected to be short-lived, as annual Airport passenger traffic is anticipated to increase to 121,000,000 by 2015.

The Airport is also considered to be the best among air cargo facilities. In 2009, the Airport was named Air Cargo Week’s Airport of the Year, becoming the first U.S. airport to earn the top prize among the annual World Air Cargo Awards. The Airport also has over 2,000,000 square feet of cargo warehouse space and is the 11th largest air cargo hub in the country and 30th worldwide. In addition to the main cargo complexes, the Airport houses a USDA approved Perishables Complex, the only one in the Southeastern U.S. The Perishables Complex features on-site distribution and transport capabilities, USDA inspection services and a USDA approved fumigation chamber. The Airport is also the only airport in the Southeast to be approved by the USDA to apply cold treatment, which is an environmentally safe alternative to methyl bromide.

This infrastructure enabled the Airport to handle more than 563,139 metric tons of cargo in 2009 (a decrease of 14.06% from 2008); international cargo also decreased from 365,351 to 312,033 metric tons in 2009. However, since November 2009, the Airport has posted upswings in year-over-year cargo traffic for six consecutive months. Cargo traffic in April 2010 was 23.44% higher than the previous year. This figure is expected to grow as Asiana Airline announced it will join the Airport’s growing list of all-cargo carriers starting September 13, 2010. Asiana Airline will operate a freighter with four weekly flights to Seoul, South Korea. The new service is expected to create up to 25 jobs and produce an annual regional economic impact of $24 million.

To facilitate the projected increase in usage, the Airport is in the tenth year of a multi-year improvement project, which is the largest public works project in the history of the State of Georgia. The program was originally budgeted to cost $5.4 billion and to take 10 years to complete, but due to cost and time overruns, the project is now expected to be complete in 2015 at an estimated cost in excess of $6 billion. The centerpiece of this expansion is the building of a fifth runway, which opened on May 16, 2006 and has helped to reduce air traffic congestion by increasing the Airport’s landings and take-offs capacity by 40%. Another major piece of the expansion is the construction of a new international terminal which broke ground in the summer of 2008 and is set for completion in April 2012. The 1.2 million-square-foot international terminal will have 12 new international gates (plus 16 domestic gates) and a 1,100-space parking facility.

The success of the Airport has also had a tremendous impact on the local economy. A recent study commissioned by the City of Atlanta’s Department of Aviation calculated total direct business revenue, including sales to airlines and service providers dependent on the Airport, to be $32.6 billion in 2009, up from $23.5 billion in 2005. In addition, Airport-related jobs in the metro region increased by 11 percent, from 393,100 in 2005 to 434,400 in 2009. The Airport jobs paid more than $4.3 billion in wages in 2009 and generated more than $3 billion in tax revenues for the government.

Finally, with respect to water transport, Georgia has two significant deepwater ports, Savannah and Brunswick, as well as two inland barge operations, Columbus and Bainbridge. Like the Airport, these ports experienced a dip in traffic for 2009, but have recently begun to see a significant uptick in activity. Out of 361 ports in the U.S., Savannah is now the fourth largest container port in the country. It is also the fastest growing container port in the U.S., while the Port of Brunswick is the 6th-largest automobile processing port in the nation. In 2008, the Port of Savannah’s total exports exceeded one million TEUs for the first time in Georgia Ports Authority’s history. However, due to the economic slowdown, Savannah’s total trade declined almost 10% in 2009 over 2008. However, similar to the airport cargo traffic, Savannah has posted upswings in year-over-year TEU throughput for six consecutive months as the May TEU total was 24.7 percent higher than the previous year.

 

D-30


Table of Contents

 

Also like the Airport, Georgia’s water ports are currently involved in significant capital improvement projects. The Brunswick Deepening Project was completed in 2007 (deepening the mean water depth to 36 feet), as was the preliminary work for the Savannah Harbor Expansion Project. The latter project is expected to be complete by 2012 (2 years prior to the Panama Canal expansion) and will deepen Savannah Harbor from 42 feet to 48 feet. The expansion of the Panama Canal and the Savannah Harbor will allow much larger container ships, twice the capacity of current vessels, to access the Savannah port.

These factors have all contributed to Georgia’s significant link to the global economy, which is recognized by the over 60 countries that have consular, trade, or chamber of commerce offices in Atlanta. More than 4000 internationally-owned facilities representing over 60 countries are located in Georgia. In 2009, $23.8 billion in exports and $53 billion in imports passed through the ports, making Georgia the 12th-largest export state and 9th-largest import state in the U.S.

Over the last several years, Georgia has been successful in attracting international business. In February 2010, Kia Motor Co. (“Kia”), a South Korean automaker, celebrated the grand opening of Kia’s first North American manufacturing facility, located in West Point, Troup County, Georgia, which is located off Interstate 85 near the Georgia-Alabama border. The $1.2 billion facility will produce 300,000 cars a year. Also, seven supplier companies have located near the facility and are expected to employ approximately 3,600 workers. The Kia plant’s economic impact to Georgia is expected to be approximately $4 billion per year. One study predicts the economic benefits brought about by the Kia plant will create 20,000 new jobs by 2012.

In May 2010, Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications announced that it will locate the company’s new Americas headquarters in Atlanta, creating about 180 jobs. A few days before Sony Ericsson’s announcement, MAGE SOLAR GMBH, a Ravensburg, Germany-based manufacturer of solar energy products, also announced that it will locate its North American headquarters in Dublin, Georgia. MAGE SOLAR markets high-grade photovoltaic modules, high-performance branded inverters, and mounting systems used in the solar energy industry. This project is estimated to bring $30 million in investment and is estimated to create 350 jobs over five years.

To help foster this international business growth, the Georgia Department of Economic Development has instituted the “Global Georgia” program to promote Georgia within the international community and prioritize international business development. The Georgia Department of Economic Development currently has 10 offices located in Brazil, Canada, Chile, China, Europe (Munich, Germany), Japan, Korea, Mexico, Israel and UK & Ireland.

This pro business climate continues to be widely recognized. Recently, Georgia has been ranked among the top 10 states in which to do business by CNBC (#10), Forbes magazine (#6), and Pollina Corporate Real Estate (#8). In 2010, Chief Executive magazine selected Georgia as 7th best state for job growth and business. This is one of many reasons why Georgia is the home to 14 Fortune 500 companies (with the City of Atlanta having the fourth largest concentration of Fortune 500 companies in the United States), including AFLAC, The Coca-Cola Company, The Home Depot, UPS, Delta Air Lines, Newell Rubbermaid, and NCR. Overall, over 75% of the Fortune 1000 companies have a presence in the Atlanta metropolitan area.

As mentioned above, historically much of this economic largesse has centered around the capital city of Atlanta. However, recently the State government has taken several steps to ensure that the other areas of Georgia share in this growth. Of particular note is the OneGeorgia Authority (the “Authority”). Established in 2000 and funded with a portion of the State’s recovery in the nationwide tobacco litigation settlement, the Authority was created to provide financial assistance to development projects targeted to assist Georgia’s economically distressed areas. It is anticipated that the Authority will invest over $1.6 billion over the term of the tobacco settlement. Unfortunately, due to the economic downturn, the fund for OneGeorgia Authority’s rural economic development program was cut from the fiscal year (“FY”) 2010 budget. However, under the FY 2011 budget, Georgia expects to provide $47,123,333 to fund the rural economic development program.

 

D-31


Table of Contents

 

The State government of Georgia and its elected officials have historically adopted a very conservative fiscal approach. This approach has resulted in the State having one of the lowest debt levels, per capita, in the United States. In 2007, Georgia had the 3rd lowest state per-capita debt and 4th lowest instate debt as a percent of personal income. As a result, Georgia is one of seven states to maintain a triple “A” bond rating by all three major rating agencies (see below).

General obligation bonds are typically issued by the State pursuant to Article VII, Section IV of the Constitution of the State of Georgia (the “Georgia Constitution”), which provides that such bonds are the direct and general obligations of the State. The operative language is set forth in Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph VI of the Georgia Constitution which provides:

“The full faith, credit and taxing power of the State are hereby pledged to the payment of all public debt incurred under this article and all such debt and the interest on the debt shall be exempt from taxation (emphasis added). . .”.

The Georgia Constitution further obligates the Georgia General Assembly to “raise by taxation and appropriate each fiscal year . such amounts as are necessary to pay debt service requirements in such fiscal year on all general obligation debt.” The Georgia Constitution also establishes a special trust fund (the “State of Georgia General Obligation Debt Sinking Fund”), which is used for the payment of debt service requirements on all general obligation debt.

The Georgia Constitution also establishes certain limitations upon the amount of debt that the State can incur. In particular, Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph II(b) of the Georgia Constitution provides that, except in certain emergency situations (i.e., in times of war or to cover a temporary budget shortfall) the State may not incur additional debt if, in that fiscal year or any subsequent year, the cumulative annual debt service for both general obligation debt and guaranteed revenue debt (including the proposed debt) will exceed 10% of the total revenue receipts, less refunds, for the prior fiscal year. The Georgia Constitution prevents State departments and agencies from circumventing these debt limitation provisions by prohibiting them from executing contracts that may be deemed to constitute a security for bonds or other public obligations. (See Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph IV of the Georgia Constitution.)

As mentioned above, the State may incur “public debt to supply a temporary deficit in the State treasury in any fiscal year created by a delay in collecting the taxes of that year. Such debt shall not exceed, in the aggregate, 5% of the total revenue receipts, less refunds, of the State treasury in the fiscal year immediately preceding the year in which such debt is incurred.” (See Georgia Constitution, Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph I(b).) However, since this provision was enacted, the State has never had to exercise this power.

Virtually all debt obligations represented by bonds issued by the State of Georgia, counties or municipalities or other public subdivisions, and public authorities require validation by a judicial proceeding prior to the issuance of such obligation. The judicial validation makes these obligations incontestable and conclusive, as provided under the Georgia Constitution. (See Article VII, Section VI, Paragraph VI of the Georgia Constitution).

As of June 30, 2009, the State had total outstanding bonded debt of $10,771,468,000. While this represented a substantial increase over the prior year ($9,545,352,000), the State remained well below the 10% threshold at 5.4%. As a result, as of June 30, 2010, the State maintained credits ratings of Aaa, AAA, and AAA from Moody’s Investor Services, Fitch, Inc., and Standard and Poor’s, respectively, making it only one of seven states to maintain such status.

The State of Georgia operates on a fiscal year beginning on July 1 and ending on June 30. Each year the State Economist, the Governor and the State Revenue Commissioner jointly prepare a revenue forecast upon which is based the State budget which is considered, amended, and approved by the Georgia General Assembly.

 

D-32


Table of Contents

 

To protect the State in the event of a decline in State revenues, and reflective of its conservative fiscal approach, in 1976 the Georgia General Assembly established the Revenue Shortfall Reserve. This reserve is funded by surplus revenue collections, and its existence was instrumental in helping the State weather the nationwide economic downturn during FY 2002-FY 2004. During those 3 years, the State was able to cover revenue shortfalls by drawing monies from this reserve (approximately $680 million over the 3 year period) rather than raising taxes or cutting vital services. With the end of the economic downturn in FY 2005, the State then began to replenish the reserve, so that at the end of FY 2007, the reserve reached its peak with a balance of $1.7 billion (exceeding the pre-FY 2002 balance). Unfortunately, due to the economic downturn, this upward trend was reversed in FY 2008 and by the end of FY 2009 the Revenue Shortfall Reserve balance was reduced to $271 million.

This reserve increase was previously funded by the State experiencing substantial increases in revenue collections. For FY 2007, Georgia experienced a 7.5% increase over prior year collections ($17,600,126,000 versus $16,366,132,000). However, starting in the latter half of FY 2008, net revenue collections have declined. In FY 2009, total revenue collections were down by $1,830,818,000 (down 10.5%) from FY 2008 levels. The effect in the various subareas showed an overall decrease, as Individual Income Taxes (down 12.2%), Motor Fuel Taxes (down 14.8%), Corporate Income Taxes (down 26.3%) and Sales and Use Taxes (down 7.6%) were down from FY 2008 levels. The only areas in which the State experienced an increase in revenue collection were Property Taxes (up 1.9%) and Alcohol Beverages Tax (up 1.2%).

Unfortunately, this downward trend continued in FY 2010. Net revenue collections were down from FY 2009 in all areas, including Individual Income Taxes (down 10%), Motor Fuel Taxes (down 3.8%), Corporate Income Taxes (down 1.4%) and Sales and Use Taxes (down 10.6%). Overall, for FY 2010, net revenue collections totaled around $14 billion, down 9.1% from FY 2009.

On June 8, 2010, Governor Sonny Perdue signed the state’s $17.9 billion FY 2011 budget, $700 million less than the original FY 2010 budget. This budget was also $300 million less than the budget originally recommended to the legislature and $3.5 billion less than the original FY 2008 budget recommendation.

One continued positive source of revenue for the State has been the Georgia Lottery Corporation. Established in 1992, the State uses profits from the lottery to fund numerous education-based initiatives, including a voluntary, state-wide pre-Kindergarten education program and the HOPE Scholarship Program (for post-secondary education). In FY 2010, Georgia Lottery transferred $883,878,000 to the State Treasury’s Lottery for Education Account, over $11.7 million more than in FY 2009. The Georgia Lottery Corp. ended FY 2010 as the only traditional U.S. lottery to experience 12 consecutive years of growth in profits.

One significant byproduct of the HOPE Scholarship Program has been the substantial increase in the percentage of college educated adults. In 1999, only 21% of Georgia’s population had a college degree, far below the national average. In 2008, 27% of the population had a college degree, on par with the national average. Furthermore, in 2010, CNBC ranked the Georgia’s workforce number 3 in the nation.

Another positive source of income to the State has been the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (“ARRA”). During FY 2009, the State recognized $725 million in ARRA funds which were used for miscellaneous purposes.

Personal income is a second key indicator of economic conditions in Georgia. Total personal income, relative to that of the U.S., has been growing despite the economic downturn. For FY 2008, Georgia’s personal income grew by 4.9%, compared to 5.3% for the nation as a whole. However, in 2009 state personal income declined by an average of 1.7%, matching the national average.

Georgia has also undergone significant political change during the 21st century. In November 2002, the State elected its first Republican Governor since Reconstruction. In addition, in light of significant election gains, as

 

D-33


Table of Contents

well as the well-publicized switch of political parties by several State Senators, the Republican Party gained control of the State Senate. This trend continued in 2004, as the Republican Party gained control of the State House and a second Republican Senator was elected (making it the first time since Reconstruction that Georgia had 2 Republican Senators). There is uncertainty surrounding the upcoming 2010 elections as, in addition to voting on the Legislature, Georgians will elect a new Governor (the current Governor is prohibited from running due to a 2-term limit).

Significant Contingent Liabilities

In response to a written request from the State Auditor, the Law Department for the State identified the following material litigation, claims and assessments as of June 30, 2009:

Plymel, et al. v. Teachers Retirement System, et al., Fulton Superior Court Civil Action No. 2004-CV-84312; Georgia Supreme Court decision reported at 282 Ga. 409 (2006). The Plaintiffs in this case filed a class action in April, 2004, seeking additional retirement benefits retroactive to the time of their individual retirement dates for a class of those retirees who elected survivorship options and who retired between 1983 and February 1, 2003, in the retirement plan administered by the Teachers Retirement System of Georgia (“TRS”). Plaintiff/Retirees alleged that TRS’ failure to use updated mortality tables resulted in miscalculations of monthly benefits and therefore additional monies are due to Plaintiffs for underpayment of benefits. The Plaintiff class numbers approximately 15,000. TRS was unsuccessful defending the case on the merits. The court in Plymel utilized a statute of limitations of six years, a pre-judgment rate of interest of 7% and a post-judgment interest rate equal to prime plus 3%. The Plaintiffs’ attorneys were awarded a fee equal to 25% of the total liability due to the class under the judgment. The total liability for TRS in this case for the adjusted benefit payments and attorneys’ fees was finalized at $414,259,402 and, following a final payment in September, 2009, is paid in full. All payments made by TRS pursuant to this class action were paid from the assets of TRS.

William A. Willis, et at. v. Employees’ Retirement System of Georgia, et al., Fulton Superior Court Civil Action No. 2007-CV-128923, filed January 31, 2007, set forth against Employees’ Retirement System of Georgia (“ERS”) exactly the same issues as were presented in Plymel v. TRS. The parties having agreed that the Plymel rulings will apply in Willis as well, ERS conceded liability on the breach of contract claim in Willis. ERS has agreed, and the Court has accepted, that the parties will use the statute of limitations and interest rate figures used in the Plymel case. The total liability for ERS in this case for the adjusted benefit payments and attorneys’ fees was finalized at $145,972,960. To date, ERS has made payments of approximately $31,309,000 in FY 2009, and approximately $43,500,000 on September 1, 2009, with approximately $71,164,000 liability outstanding and payable over time. All payments made by ERS pursuant to this class action are paid from the assets of ERS. The only remaining issue outstanding in Willis concerns application of an administrative rule that limits retirement benefits to 90% of the highest salary earned by the member while actively employed. This issue was scheduled to be heard before the court in September, 2009, but the hearing was postponed pending settlement discussions. A status conference was scheduled for January 21, 2010. The outcome of this issue is not anticipated to have an appreciable effect on the total liability amount.

Smitha Anderson v. PSERS, et al., Fulton Superior Court Civil Action No. 2008-CV-154757. This is another class action presenting the same issues as Willis and Plymel, set forth against the Public School Employees Retirement System (“PSERS”). The parties agreed to apply the same statute of imitations and interest rates determined in Willis and Plymel. The total liability for PSERS in this case for adjusted benefit payments and attorneys’ fees was finalized at $2,168,024. To date, PSERS has made payments of approximately $1,086,000, with approximately $1,082,000 liability outstanding and payable over time. All payments made by PSERS pursuant to this class action are paid from the assets of PSERS.

Georgia Power Company v. Graham, Fulton County Superior Court Civil Action File No. 2007-CV 137383 filed on or about July 24, 2007. This case arose from Georgia Power’s claim for the Port Tax Credit (the “Credit”) provided by O.C.G.A. § 48-7-40.15. Georgia Power asserts that its increase in imports through Georgia

 

D-34


Table of Contents

ports during the tax years 2002 through 2004 inclusive qualifies Georgia Power to receive a Credit based income tax refund. The total Credit claimed is in excess of $50 million, although the amount of refund for each taxable year is capped, with the excess Credit carrying forward to subsequent tax years. The Commissioner has answered the Complaint asserting that Georgia Power Company does not satisfy the statutory requirements to qualify for the Credit. Discovery in this case is complete and the parties have filed cross-motions for summary judgment. It is anticipated that oral argument on the cross-motions for summary judgment will be heard in January 2010.

Western Surety Company and Continental Casualty Company v. the State of Georgia, Department of Transportation, Heard County Superior Court Civil Action No. 08-v-l06. The plaintiff, Western Surety Company and Continental Casualty Company (“Western Surety”) was the surety company for Bruce Albea Company (“BAC”) on a Georgia Department of Transportation (“GDOT”) project. On June 29, 2007 BAC delivered a notice to GDOT advising that it was voluntarily abandoning the project. GDOT directed Western Surety to take over the work in accordance with the construction contract and Western Surety subsequently hired a completion contractor. Western Surety filed this action against GDOT on March 18, 2008, alleging three breach of contract causes of action, two related to price escalations of asphalt both prior to and subsequent to the original completion date, and the third alleging the failure to pay an outstanding contract balance in excess of $500,000 for work performed by the completion contractor. Western Surety also alleges a claim under the Prompt Payment Act. The case is currently in discovery. Plaintiffs have not stated a final claim amount but preliminary indications of potential damages sought are approximately $9,000,000.

Salary-Related Litigation: A state employee and certain teachers have brought separate law suits challenging steps the State has taken to manage expenditures relative to reduced revenues. In Stalling, et at. v. State of Georgia, et al., several school teachers contend that: (i) a statutory amendment making the payment of monetary incentives to teachers for achieving national certification “subject to appropriations” of funding for such incentive payments and (ii) any subsequent reductions in the appropriations are unconstitutional. In Estill, et al. v. State of Georgia, et al., a state employee seeks class certification and contends that state employees were entitled under state law to a general salary increase of 2 1/2% for the latter half of FY 2009 on the basis of initial appropriations (later reduced). Both cases are pending in the Superior Court of Fulton County and are in the initial stages of litigation. The State’s position is that the statute challenged in the Stalling case is constitutional; that the actions of the defendants in both cases were within their lawful authority, and that the plaintiffs in both cases are not entitled to any relief.

Citibank USA, N.A., et al. v. Bart L. Graham, Fulton County Superior Court, Case No.2007-CV-140161. This action was filed on September 20, 2007 and seeks a sales tax refund of $10,147,730 from the Department of Revenue. It involves a legal issue decided in the Department’s favor in Citibank USA, N.A., et al. v. Graham, Fulton County Superior Court, Case No. 2005-CV-109444, which was filed December 2, 2005 to obtain a $2,281,990 refund. Citibank’s application for discretionary appeal in the first lawsuit was denied by the Georgia Court of Appeals. The issues in second case are fully briefed, and we are awaiting a decision on the Department’s motion to dismiss.

Kenny A., et at. v. Sonny Perdue, Department of Human Resources, et al., United States Court of Appeals for the Eleventh Circuit, Nos. 06-15514, 06-15874. This was a class action lawsuit filed on behalf of 2,200 children in state custody asserting systemic deficiencies in foster care in Fulton and DeKalb counties. A Consent Decree was entered wherein the Department of Human Resources (“DHR”) agreed to make a number of specific system-wide management and infrastructure reforms. The District Court appointed two independent accountability agents to monitor DHR’s progress and awarded attorneys’ fees to the plaintiffs in the amount of $10.5 million. DHR appealed the award of attorneys’ fees to the Eleventh Circuit Court of Appeals. In July, 2008, the Court of Appeals affirmed the entire award. However, the majority opinion noted that the panel grudgingly affirmed the $4.5 million multiplier applied by the district court because they were bound by Eleventh Circuit precedent which may conflict with that of the United States Supreme Court. In light of the tone of the majority and concurring opinions, DHR filed a petition for rehearing en banc in the Eleventh Circuit which was denied on November 5, 2008. On April 6, 2009, the U.S. Supreme Court granted the State’s petition for

 

D-35


Table of Contents

certiorari on the award of attorney’s fees in this case, and oral argument was conducted before the Supreme Court on October 14, 2009. A decision in this case is not expected until mid-2010.

Buford Dam/Lake Lanier Water Litigation: The State is involved in multi-district litigation in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida which includes several cases involving the operation of Buford Dam and Lake Lanier. In 1946, the U.S. Congress authorized and funded the construction of the Buford Dam, and granted the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers (the “Corps”) authority to operate Buford Dam and the resulting reservoir, Lake Lanier. Water supply was declared to be an incidental purpose of the project. Construction on the dam commenced in 1950 and lasted approximately six years. In 1958, the U.S. Congress enacted the Water Supply Act of 1958, which allowed the Corps to use its reservoir projects for municipal water supply subject to certain restrictions. During the 1970’s the Corps began to enter into water supply contracts with certain Georgia municipalities allocating water from Lake Lanier storage for local water supply. The Corps took the position that this was an appropriate use. However, when Atlanta and other surrounding communities sought additional water in the late 1980’s, the Corps prepared a draft post authorization change report as part of the process of granting the request. Subsequently, Alabama initiated litigation against the Corps in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Alabama, in which Florida and Georgia intervened.

Following almost twenty years of litigation and negotiations involving the use of water among various private entities and governmental entities in Georgia, Alabama, and Florida, multiple cases involving the use of the waters of the Apalachicola-Chattahoochee-Flint River Basin were referred to the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida (the “District Court”), sitting as a multi-district litigation court, for resolution. The main components of such litigation are: (1) a case involving the rights of Georgia municipalities to use water from Lake Lanier (the “Georgia I” case); (2) a case involving the right of the Southeastern Federal Power Customers Association to be compensated for loss of hydroelectric power production due to the increasing use of water from Lake Lanier by Georgia municipalities; and (3) a case dealing with the quantity of water that the Corps should release from Lake Lanier to support the habitat of certain endangered species in the Apalachicola River in Florida in purported violation of the Endangered Species Act (the “ESA Litigation”). The ESA Litigation is in the early stages.

On July 17, 2009, the District Court issued an order making the following findings in the Georgia I case (the “Georgia I Order”): (1) water supply is not an authorized purpose of Lake Lanier, i.e., the lake was not built to provide for water supplies to municipalities in Georgia; (2) the quantity of water usage that would be authorized under a 1989 draft post authorization change in use report prepared by the Corps would require approval by the U.S. Congress; (3) the present level of water usage from Lake Lanier by Georgia municipalities violates the Federal Water Supply Act of 1958 and therefore is not authorized; and (4) the request by Georgia to the Corps, made in 2000, for additional water from Lake Lanier, would also violate the Federal Water Supply Act of 1958, and would be unauthorized. The Georgia I Order allows Georgia municipalities to continue using water from Lake Lanier for three years at current water usage levels in order to achieve a Congressional or other settlement, after which water usage from Lake Lanier (in the form of withdrawals from the lake and releases for downstream withdrawal) must revert to the “baseline” operation of the mid-1970’s, with an exception for withdrawal of 10 million gallons of water per day for the cities of Buford and Gainesville, Georgia. The State has filed a notice of appeal and has also requested that the District Court enter final judgment in Georgia I on the theory that all issues in such case are resolved. The District Court has declined the State’s request for the entry of final judgment. Alabama and Florida, as opposing parties, contend that the Georgia I Order is not appealable and have asked the Eleventh Circuit Court of Appeals to dismiss Georgia’s appeal.

Maryland

Risks of Concentration. The following information as to certain state specific considerations is given to investors in view of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s policy of concentrating its investments in Maryland issuers. This information supplements the information in the prospectus. This information constitutes only a brief summary, does not purport to be a complete description and is based on information from official

 

D-36


Table of Contents

statements relating to securities offerings of the State of Maryland (“Maryland” or the “State”) and other sources that are generally available to investors as of July 15, 2010. While generally believed to be accurate, we have not independently verified the information in this summary and will not be updating it during the year. Estimates and projections are based upon assumptions which could be affected by many factors and there can be no assurance that such estimates and projections will prove, or continue, to be accurate.

Unless stated otherwise, the ratings indicated are for obligations of the State and are current as of July 15, 2010; there can be no assurance that these ratings will not change. Bonds issued by Maryland’s political subdivisions and other issuers of tax-exempt bonds may have different ratings which are unrelated to the ratings assigned to State bonds. Similarly, conduit bonds issued for private borrowers have ratings which are unrelated to the ratings assigned to State bonds.

Maryland and its economy. According to the 2000 Census, Maryland’s population on April 1 of that year was 5,296,486, an increase of 10.8% from the 1990 Census. Maryland’s population is concentrated in urban areas. Approximately 87.0% of Maryland’s population lives in the densely populated Baltimore-Washington region. Per capita income in 2009 was $48,285 in Maryland, compared to the national average of $39,138 in that year. Per capita income in Maryland increased at an annual rate of 0.3% in 2009, higher than the national decline of 2.6%.

Maryland’s economy is more reliant on the service and government sectors than the nation as a whole, while the manufacturing sector is much less significant in Maryland than it is nationwide. As one of the wealthier states, in Maryland a greater share of personal income is derived from dividends, interest and rent, and a lesser share comes from transfer payments. Maryland’s economy is also particularly sensitive to changes in federal employment and spending. The percentage of personal income earned from federal and military employment in 2009 was 10.5% for Maryland residents, compared to 4.1% nationwide. Maryland’s unemployment rate has been lower than the rest of the country for the past ten years, while the labor force in Maryland has grown more slowly than the rest of the country in seven of the last ten years. In 2009, the unemployment rate in Maryland was 7.0%, as compared to a national unemployment rate of 9.3%. In May 2010 these rates had increased to 7.2% in Maryland and 9.7% in the United States as a result of the ongoing economic downturn.

State fiscal information. The Maryland Constitution requires the State to enact a balanced budget for each of its fiscal years, which run from July 1 to June 30. Maryland’s fiscal year 2009 ended with a $87.2 million general fund balance on a budgetary basis, reflecting a $349.9 million decrease compared to the balance projected at the time the fiscal year 2010 budget was enacted. In addition, there was a balance of $691.8 million in the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund. The Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund provides financial support for future needs of the State and is intended to reduce the need for future tax and other revenue increases. However, the State can move funds in the Revenue Stabilization Account to cover other areas of its budget, and has done so recently. As described below, over the last few years the State has used reserve funds to pay for operating shortfalls. General fund revenues on a budgetary basis realized in the State’s fiscal year 2009 were below estimates by $356.4 million, or 2.7%. On a GAAP basis, the fiscal year 2009 reserved general fund balance was $1,363.0 million, while the unreserved, designated and undesignated, fund balances were $146.9 million and $0.0 million, respectively; these balances compare to the reserved general fund balance of $1,388.2 million, and unreserved, designated and undesignated, fund balances of $538.0 million and $959.4 million, respectively, at the end of fiscal year 2008.

2010 budget. On April 13, 2009, the General Assembly approved the budget for fiscal year 2010. The fiscal year 2010 budget included, among other things: (1) funds to the State’s retirement and pension systems consistent with the “corridor” methodology of funding as prescribed by statute; (2) $5,736.3 million in aid to local governments from general funds reflecting full funding of the Thornton public school assistance program; and (3) deficiency appropriations of $273.0 million for fiscal year 2009, including a reduction of $364.9 million in the Department of Health and Mental Hygiene primarily in Medicaid due to the availability of federal stimulus funds as further described below.

 

D-37


Table of Contents

 

As part of the fiscal year 2010 budget plan, the General Assembly enacted the Budget Reconciliation and Financing Act of 2009 (the “2009 Act”), which provided for transfers to the General Fund in fiscal year 2010 of $216.3 million, including $31.0 million of transfer tax revenues and $161.9 million from the local share of highway user revenues. The 2009 Act and other legislative actions cumulatively decreased fiscal year 2010 revenues by $24.8 million.

Reductions to required fiscal year 2010 general fund appropriations included $34.0 million in aid to community colleges; $24.0 million due to modifications in the local jail reimbursement program; $16.1 million representing a decrease in the State share (from 80% to 70%) of the cost of placing students with special needs in non-public establishments; and $11.8 million reflecting the elimination of a State match of employee contributions to the deferred compensation plan. The fiscal year 2010 budget did not include funds for any employee cost of living adjustment or merit increases. State aid to primary and secondary schools included $10.8 million in Education Trust Fund revenues generated through anticipated licensing fees for Video Lottery Terminals and $297.3 million in State Fiscal Stabilization Funds authorized by the American Recovery and Reimbursement Act of 2009 (“ARRA”). The fiscal year 2010 budget also included $660.0 million in additional federal funds for the Medicaid program resulting from increased federal funding authorized by ARRA.

The fiscal year 2010 budget included $139.9 million for the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund. The required certain payment of $63.0 million from the Dedicated Purpose Account to the Maryland Transportation Authority for certain transportation projects was reduced and funded with general obligation bonds instead. Transfers from the State Reserve Fund to the general fund totaled $210.0 million in fiscal year 2010.

Subsequent Events – fiscal year 2010. In order to close emerging gaps between anticipated revenues and budgeted expenditures, the Governor proposed, and the Board of Public Works approved, general fund budget reductions of $205.3 million on July 22, 2009, $223.3 million on August 26, 2009 and $102.8 million on November 18, 2009.

As part of the fiscal year 2011 budget plan discussed below, the General Assembly enacted the Budget Reconciliation and Financing Act of 2010 (the “2010 Act”), legislation that authorizes various funding changes resulting in increased general fund revenues and decreased general fund appropriations. The 2010 Act authorized transfers to the general fund in fiscal year 2010 of $317.4 million from various special fund balances, including $136.2 million from a highway user revenue account and $133.3 million from the University System of Maryland. An additional $330.1 million in unexpended capital program balances were authorized for transfer to the general fund, including $103.1 million from the local jurisdictions’ share of certain park improvement funds. The 2010 Act and other legislative actions cumulatively increase fiscal year 2010 general fund revenues by $58.8 million. As of July 15, 2010, the State estimated that the general fund balance on a budgetary basis at June 30, 2010 would be $153.8 million. In addition, the State estimated that the balance in the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund would be $612.1 million at June 30, 2010, equal to 4.8% of estimated general fund revenues.

2011 Budget. On April 12, 2010, the General Assembly enacted the budget for fiscal year 2011. The fiscal year 2011 budget includes, among other things: (1) funds to the State’s retirement and pension systems consistent with the “corridor” methodology of funding as prescribed by statute; (2) $5,741.6 million in aid to local governments from general funds; (3) $15.0 million to the State Reserve Fund; and (4) deficiency appropriations of $195.8 million for fiscal year 2010, including $108.9 million for Medicaid and $39.3 million for public education. The fiscal year 2011 budget does not include funds for any employee cost of living adjustment, merit increases, nor a match for contributions to deferred compensation.

As part of the fiscal year 2011 budget plan, the General Assembly enacted the 2010 Act, which increases fiscal year 2011 general fund revenues by $35.5 million, including $22.1 million by diverting to the general fund a portion of sales taxes and motor fuel taxes from the Chesapeake Bay 2010 Fund, $11.0 million resulting from

 

D-38


Table of Contents

changes in the allocation of interest earnings that otherwise would be retained in special funds accounts, and $2.4 million in admissions and amusement tax attributable to the cultural arts. The fiscal year 2011 budget also includes net general fund revenue increases of $9.2 million from various sources. The 2010 Act authorizes transfers to the general fund in fiscal year 2011 of $22.3 million, including $11.7 million from the University System of Maryland and $6.0 million in furlough-related savings from various special funds. The 2010 Act also authorizes transfers to the general fund totaling $111.7 million from capital-related special fund balances, including $45.0 million from the Bay Restoration Fund and $54.0 million in transfer tax revenues.

State aid to primary and secondary schools includes $114.0 million in Education Trust Fund revenues generated through $60.0 million in anticipated revenue from Video Lottery Terminals and $54.0 million in gaming licensing fees. The 2011 budget also includes $389.0 million in additional federal funds for the Medicaid program. The State has indicated that it anticipates federal legislation extending the enhanced federal Medicaid match provisions originally authorized by ARRA; at this time, this legislation has not been enacted.

The fiscal year 2011 budget includes $15.0 million for the State Reserve Fund in the Dedicated Purpose Account for distribution to the Department of Health and Mental Hygiene for the Prince George’s County Health Care System. The fiscal year 2011 budget also eliminates operating funds for certain road improvements, which will be funded in fiscal year 2011 by general obligation bonds instead. No transfers from the State Reserve Fund to the general fund are planned in fiscal year 2011.

As of July 15, 2010, the State projected the general fund balance on a budgetary basis at June 30, 2011 to be $203.9 million. In addition, the State projected the balance in the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund to be $630.7 million at June 30, 2011, equal to 4.8% of estimated general fund revenues.

Federal stimulus funding. ARRA provides support for the states, including the State, by funding infrastructure, education programs, human services programs, and providing discretionary funds. ARRA provides over $4.5 billion in formula funding to Maryland governments. ARRA grants to Maryland provide $421.7 million for educational programs, $765.2 million for infrastructure programs, and $477.7 million for other programs. ARRA also includes $101.8 million in grants to local governments and aid organizations that are not appropriated in the State budget. These funds will be distributed directly to the local governments and aid organizations.

ARRA also provides federal grants for which State and local governments must compete, including grants to support law enforcement, habitat conservation, and the arts. It is uncertain how much of these funds the State or Maryland local governments will receive and, accordingly, they are not included in ARRA estimates for Maryland.

ARRA’s most significant impact for Maryland is the $2.9 billion that can support State general fund commitments. These funds support Medicaid, education, and discretionary State spending; the funds are used in the place of general funds to sustain State funding from fiscal years 2009 to 2011. When the funds are no longer available, the State and other Maryland local government will need to replace the funds or reduce spending. ARRA also permits 18.2% of the Fiscal Stabilization funds to support general government services; these funds, which total $160.1 million, have been applied $1.5 million in fiscal year 2009, $79.6 million to 2010 and the remaining $79.0 million is included in the fiscal year 2011 budget.

Other fiscal challenges facing Maryland. The State also has a substantial unfunded actuarial liability, estimated to be approximately $18.4 billion as of June 30, 2009, or 172.2% of payroll, on the pension plans guaranteed by the State. Other retirement programs administered by the State also are experiencing material shortfalls, as are the retirement programs of the City of Baltimore. In addition, after several years of analysis of the State’s other post-employment benefit (“OPEB”) liabilities, the State has determined that the State’s unfunded actuarial accrued liability for OPEB liabilities was $15.5 billion as of June 30, 2009; the amount held in trust to pay OPEB liabilities was $174.3 million as of that date. A commission formed in 2006 to develop a

 

D-39


Table of Contents

plan with respect to the State’s OPEB liabilities reported in an Interim Report released in December 2008 that, in its view, Maryland cannot sustain the current level of retiree health benefits. The commission is continuing to explore options for redesigning retired health benefits and/or the way the State pays for them to arrive at a solution that is both fiscally sound and fair to current and retired State employees.

State-level municipal obligations. Neither the Constitution nor general laws of Maryland impose any limit on the amount of debt the State can incur. However, Maryland’s Constitution prohibits the creation of State debt unless it is authorized by a law that provides for the collection of an annual tax or taxes sufficient to pay the interest when due and to discharge the principal within 15 years of the date of issuance. Taxes levied for this purpose may not be repealed or applied to any other purpose until the debt is fully discharged. These restrictions do not necessarily apply to other issuers within the State. The General Assembly, by separate enabling act, typically authorizes a particular loan for a particular project or purpose. In its fiscal year 2009 capital program, 49% of the new general obligations bond authorizations represent financing of State-owned capital facilities and State programs, 50% represent financing of capital improvements owned by local governmental units, and 1% represent financing of capital improvements owned by non-profit or other private entities. The Board of Public Works authorizes State general obligation bond issues and supervises the expenditure of funds received therefrom, as well as all funds appropriated for capital improvements other than roads, bridges and highways. The State has projected to have approximately $9,695.1 billion of State tax-supported debt outstanding as of July 31, 2010.

The State’s public indebtedness can be generally divided into the following categories:

 

   

The State and various counties, agencies and municipalities of the State issue general obligation bonds, payable from ad valorem taxes, for capital improvements and for various projects, including local-government initiatives and grants to private, nonprofit, cultural and educational institutions. The State’s real property tax is pledged exclusively to the repayment of its bonds. The Board of Public Works is required to fix the property tax rate by each May 1 in an amount sufficient to pay all debt service on the State’s general obligation bonds for the coming fiscal year. At least since the end of the Civil War, Maryland has paid the principal of and interest on its general obligation bonds when due. As of July 15, 2010, the State’s general obligation bonds were rated AAA by Fitch, Aaa by Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., and AAA by Standard & Poor’s. We cannot assure you that such ratings will be maintained in the future.

 

   

The Maryland Department of Transportation issues limited special-obligation bonds for transportation purposes, payable primarily from specific, fixed-rate excise taxes and other revenues generated from the financed facilities, including an expansion to BWI airport, rail transportation facilities, highways and other transportation facilities. Holders of these bonds are not entitled to look to any other sources of payment. The 2009 General Assembly established a maximum outstanding principal amount of $661.8 million as of June 30, 2010, for all nontraditional debt of the Maryland Department of Transportation. Nontraditional debt outstanding is defined as any debt instrument that is not a consolidated transportation bond or Grant Anticipation Revenue Vehicle (“GARVEE”) Bond; such debt includes, but is not limited to, certificates of participation (documented by conditional purchase agreements), debt backed by customer facility charges, passenger facility charges, or other revenues, and debt issued by Maryland Economic Development Corporation (“MEDCO”) or any other third party on behalf of the Maryland Department of Transportation. As of March 31, 2010, the outstanding principal amount of such nontraditional debt was $671.4 million and is projected to be $661.8 million at June 30, 2010.

 

   

The Maryland Stadium Authority issues limited special-obligation bonds and notes to finance stadiums, convention centers and recreational facilities payable primarily from lease rentals, sports lottery and other revenues. At March 31, 2010, the principal amount of outstanding Maryland Stadium Authority bonds and capital leases was $249.7 million.

 

D-40


Table of Contents

 

   

Certain other State units, such as Maryland’s university systems, the Maryland Transportation Authority and the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration, as well as several local governments, are authorized to borrow funds pursuant to legislation that expressly provides that the State will not be deemed to have given any pledge or assurance of repayment, and for which the State will have no liability for repayment. These obligations are payable solely from specific non-tax revenues of the borrowers, including loan obligations from nonprofit organizations, corporations and other private entities. The issuers of these obligations are subject to various economic risks and uncertainties, and the credit quality of the securities issued by them may vary considerably from the quality of obligations backed by the full faith and credit of the State of Maryland. For example, the Maryland Transportation Authority, like the Maryland Department of Transportation, has issued bonds which are payable solely from collections from airline travel; declines in air traffic at BWI airport could impede repayment of such bonds.

 

   

During the 2004 General Session, the General Assembly created the Bay Restoration Fund to be managed by the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration. The Bay Restoration Fund receives a mandatory fee of $30 per year per equivalent dwelling unit from users of sewerage systems in Maryland, as well as $30 per year from septic system users. The Bay Restoration Fund sewer fee generated $53.3 million in revenue (cash basis) during fiscal year 2009. Future sewer fee revenues are projected at approximately $55.0 million per year. The sewer fee revenues are pledged, to the extent necessary, as security for revenue bonds issued by the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration, the proceeds of which will be applied primarily to provide grant funds to upgrade wastewater treatment plants with enhanced nutrient removal technology. The first $50 million of Bay Restoration Revenue Bonds were issued on June 25, 2008. Between 2010 and 2012, the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration expects to issue an additional $480.0 million in Bay Restoration Revenue Bonds. A fiscal year 2010 transfer of $155.0 million and a fiscal year 2011 transfer of $45.0 million from the Bay Restoration Fund to the general fund will not affect the security or issuance of these bonds.

 

   

The State, its agencies and departments, and the various localities also enter into a variety of municipal leases, installment purchase, conditional purchase, sale-leaseback and similar transactions to finance the construction and acquisition of facilities and equipment. Such arrangements are not general obligations to which the issuing government’s taxing power is pledged but are ordinarily backed by the issuer’s covenant to budget for, appropriate and make the payments due on such obligations. Such arrangements generally contain “non-appropriation” clauses which provide that the issuing government has no obligation to make payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a yearly basis. In the event that appropriations are not made, the issuing government cannot be held contractually liable for the payments. As of June 30, 2010 the total of such financings outstanding was $210.6 million.

Although the State has the authority to make short-term borrowings up to a maximum of $100 million in anticipation of taxes and other receipts, in the past 20 years the State has not issued short-term tax anticipation notes or made any other similar short-term borrowings for cash flow purposes.

Other issuers of municipal bonds. Maryland can be divided into 24 subdivisions, comprised of 23 counties plus the independent City of Baltimore. Some of the counties and the City of Baltimore operate pursuant to the provisions of charters or codes of their own adoption, while others operate pursuant to State statutes. As a result, not all localities in Maryland follow the debt-authorization procedures outlined above. Maryland counties and the City of Baltimore typically receive most of their revenues from taxes on real and personal property, income taxes, miscellaneous taxes, and aid from the State. Their expenditures include public education, public safety, public works, health, public welfare, court and correctional services, and general governmental costs. Although some of these localities have received ratings of AAA from rating agencies, these ratings are often achieved through bond insurance or other credit enhancement. Over the last several years, however, repeated downgrades

 

D-41


Table of Contents

of the ratings of bond insurers have resulted in substantially lower ratings on these bonds. Additionally, most issuers within Maryland have received lower ratings than the State.

Many of Maryland’s counties have established subsidiary agencies with bond-issuing powers, such as sanitary districts, housing authorities, parking revenue authorities and industrial development authorities. For example, the Washington Suburban Sanitary Commission, which provides water and sewerage services in the District of Columbia area, and the Maryland-National Capital Park and Planning Commission, which administers a park system, both issue bonds. Many of the municipal corporations in Maryland have also issued bonds. In addition, all Maryland localities have the authority under State law to issue bonds payable from payments from private borrowers. All of these entities are subject to various economic risks and uncertainties, including the risks faced by the Maryland economy generally, and the credit quality of the securities issued by them varies with the financial strengths of the respective borrowers and the revenues pledged to the repayment of the bonds.

Local governments in Maryland receive substantial aid from the State for a variety of programs, including education costs and discretionary grants. However, cuts in State aid to local governments, lower tax and other receipts and the overall economic situation have required some Maryland counties and municipalities to find creative sources of revenue and to cut services and expenditures. The ongoing budget shortfalls at the State level, as well as other future events, might require further reductions in, or the discontinuation of, some or all State aid payments to local governments. Cutbacks in State aid and reductions in other local revenues are adversely affecting local economies.

Risks and uncertainties. Generally, the primary default risk associated with government obligations is the nonpayment of taxes or other revenues supporting the debt. In addition, certain debt obligations in the Fund may be obligations of issuers other than the State, such as those listed above. Although the State has received the highest ratings from ratings agencies, local governments and other issuers may have higher debt-to-assessment ratios, and/or greater credit risk, than the State itself, and as a result may be unable to repay their obligations. Other obligations are issued by entities which lack taxing power to repay their obligations, such as industrial development authorities and housing authorities. Certain debt may consist of obligations which are payable solely from the revenues of private institutions within one industry, such as health care. The default risk may be higher for such obligations, since any decline in that one industry could impede repayment. Finally, the economic environment has had and continues to have a substantial impact on the bond markets. The State, its political subdivisions and other conduit borrowers regularly issue bonds to fund capital projects. Since the credit crisis began, interest rates on some financings have increased and other financing sources have dried up. As a result, some local governments and other borrowers have experienced increased borrowing costs or cash flow difficulties.

As described above, State and local revenues have been reduced due, at least in part, to the current economic environment. Substantial losses in the job market, considerable declines in individual and business income taxes and transfer and other ad valorem property taxes, coupled with reduced consumer and business expenditures have already impacted State and local revenues and are likely to continue to do so for some time. The cumulative effect of the ongoing market uncertainty and the economy makes the economic outlook of the State, its political subdivisions and other borrowers challenging and at the same time, difficult to predict. While Maryland’s economy is unusually dependent on the federal government because a large percentage of Maryland residents are employed either by the federal government or in companies working with the federal government, other sectors of Maryland’s economy are experiencing the same difficulties as in the rest of the nation. Additionally, funds received by the State and any localities under ARRA are only temporarily available to support general fund commitments. Maryland and its local governments will need to decrease spending, cut employment, raise taxes and take other measures to balance their budgets for several years.

The impact of State budget cuts places an additional burden on local governments. The City of Baltimore and other political subdivisions and municipalities, many of which were already experiencing fiscal pressures due to general economic conditions and other factors, are themselves experiencing lower revenues due to lower

 

D-42


Table of Contents

income tax and property transfer tax revenues. Many of these local governments depend on State aid, and cutbacks in such aid as a result of the State’s own financial issues is adversely affecting local budgets.

Finally, the ongoing economic environment and credit crisis could affect the cash flow and ability of many conduit borrowers on bonds to service the debt service payments on their bonds; many of these entities may be unable to raise revenues due to weak consumer demand or other factors or may be experiencing higher costs (e.g., increased charity care), so the combination of higher interest rates, lack of access to capital and lower revenues or higher expenses could result in defaults on these conduit obligations. Similarly, reductions in State aid (e.g. to private educational and social or health institutions) may affect the budget of private borrowers.

North Carolina

State Economy

According to 2008 U.S. Census Bureau estimates, the State of North Carolina (“North Carolina” or the “State”) is the tenth most populous state, with a population greater than 9.2 million people. Its economy is a combination of manufacturing, agriculture, services and tourism. There is also a significant military presence in North Carolina, contributing almost 7% of the gross state product, according to a 2008 study by the North Carolina Department of Commerce.

The State is transitioning from an economy based mainly in agriculture and manufacturing (e.g. furniture and textiles) to a services and goods based economy. Greater than 50% of North Carolina’s labor force is employed in one of four industry sectors: health care and societal assistance, retail trade, manufacturing and educational services. However, the manufacturing slowdown continues to be felt in North Carolina. Manufacturing employment, which currently constitutes approximately 11.5% of total employment, has decreased significantly from 2003, when it constituted approximately 16% of total employment. While North Carolina remains the national leader in textile employment, job losses in the industry, which have been mounting for decades, are expected to continue. Nationwide, employment in the textile industry is expected to decline by 35% through the year 2016.

The national and global economic downturn has had a negative impact on North Carolina’s economy. North Carolina’s labor market has contracted significantly since January 2008, with the unemployment rate rising from 5.0% in January 2008 to 10.8% in April 2010. During the same period, total employment (as reported by the Employment Security Commission of North Carolina) decreased by over 251,000 jobs or 5.8%. The unemployment rate in April 2010 was the nation’s fourteenth highest and is slightly below the State’s highest recorded unemployment rate since the State began keeping seasonally adjusted data in 1976 (11.2% in February 2010). The unemployment rate is predicted to peak in 2010, followed by a decrease to approximately 9.0% in 2011. The education and health services sector, which is projected to expand 2.5% over the next several years, will likely lead the growth in employment, while construction and manufacturing will likely suffer longer than other industry sectors.

State Budget

The North Carolina Constitution requires that the total expenditures of the State for the fiscal period covered by the budget not exceed the total receipts during the period plus any surplus remaining in the State Treasury at the beginning of the period. The State’s budget is originally proposed by the Governor (the “Governor’s Recommended Budget”) in odd-numbered years. The Governor’s Recommended Budget is a biennial budget covering the two fiscal years starting July 1 of the year in which it is first proposed, and ending June 30 of the second year thereafter. The North Carolina General Assembly (the “General Assembly”), which has final authority to approve the State’s budget, considers the Governor’s Recommended Budget during its long session, held in odd-numbered years, making changes as it sees fit. The final budget must be ratified by both houses of the General Assembly and either signed into law by the Governor or, if the Governor vetoes the bill, overridden

 

D-43


Table of Contents

by a 3/5 vote of the General Assembly. During its short session, held in even-numbered years, the General Assembly has the power to adjust the certified budget for the second year of the biennium, based on revenues collected and economic and other considerations. The biennial budget for fiscal years 2009-2010 and 2010-2011 was ratified by the General Assembly on August 5, 2009 and signed into law by the Governor on August 7, 2009 (the “Certified Budget”).

The Certified Budget included revenue adjustments and significant revisions to the State’s tax structure, together expected to generate approximately $3 billion in additional revenue over the biennium. The majority of this additional revenue was expected to come from various changes to the State’s tax laws, including a temporary increase in the sales tax rate, temporary surtaxes on individual and corporate income, a slight broadening of the sales tax base, and an increased excise tax on tobacco and alcohol sales. The additional revenue available during the biennium, consisting in large part of these changes in tax laws, totaled $1.4 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $1.5 billion in fiscal year 2010-11.

On April 13, 2010, the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly released its memorandum on the revised consensus revenue forecast for the remainder of the biennium. The consensus forecast represents a revenue forecast agreed upon by the Fiscal Research Division and the North Carolina Office of State Budget and Management and provides one basis upon which the General Assembly makes adjustments to the Certified Budget during its short session. According to the consensus forecast, the revenues for 2009-2010 are expected to fall short of the Certified Budget’s forecast by $391 million. The shortfall for 2010-2011 is even more severe, with revenues forecast to be $788 million less than anticipated in the Certified Budget.

On June 30, 2010, the General Assembly ratified, and the Governor signed into law, a bill adjusting the second year of the Certified Budget, making changes to the fiscal year 2010-2011 appropriations and revenues. The fiscal year 2010-2011 adjustment combines reductions in spending across a number of State departments and agencies with adjustments to revenue, in order to close the projected revenue gap and balance the budget, as required by the North Carolina Constitution.

Financial Report

On June 15, 2010, the Office of the State Controller released its General Fund Monthly Financial Report for the period ended May 31, 2010. The General Fund had a negative balance in unreserved funds of $18.4 million, compared to a negative balance of $344.8 million as of May 31, 2009. For May 2010, North Carolina’s tax revenues, net of refunds, increased by $115.9 million, or 11.6%, compared to May 2009. For the year to date through May 31, 2010, net tax revenues reflected an increase of $644.7 million, or 4.2%. For the year to date through May 31, 2010, investment earnings declined from the same time period in 2009 by $75.6 million, or 67%, due to lower rates of return on investment and lower cash availability for investment.

Litigation

The State is currently involved in certain litigation where adverse decisions could have a material impact on State finances. Included in this litigation are the following matters, although not exhaustive of all pending matters:

In Hoke County, et al, v. State of North Carolina and State Board of Education, students and the boards of education in five North Carolina counties sought a declaration that the public school system of North Carolina, by failing to provide adequate or substantially equal educational opportunities, by denying due process of law, and by violating various public education statutes, violates the North Carolina Constitution. After its motion to dismiss was denied, the State appealed, and the North Carolina Supreme Court held that North Carolina’s funding system for public education does not unlawfully discriminate against low wealth counties. However, the court held that the North Carolina Constitution guarantees every child the opportunity to obtain a sound basic education and remanded the case for trial. On October 26, 2000, the trial court held that at-risk children in North

 

D-44


Table of Contents

Carolina are constitutionally entitled to such pre-kindergarten educational programs as may be necessary to prepare them for higher levels of education and the “sound basic education” mandated by the North Carolina Supreme Court. On March 26, 2001, the trial court ordered all parties to determine why certain school systems were succeeding without additional funding. The court re-opened the trial, in the fall of 2001, to call additional

witnesses, resulting in the trial court directing the executive and legislative branches to take corrective action necessary to ensure that every child has the opportunity to obtain a sound, basic education. The North Carolina Supreme Court affirmed the trial court, with the exception of the requirement for pre-kindergarten educational programs. The State is currently taking steps to respond to the court’s directives. The amount of resources which may ultimately be required is not yet known but, according to the Office of the State Controller’s Comprehensive Annual Financial Report for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2009, could exceed $100 million.

In N.C. School Boards Association, et al. v. Richard H. Moore, State Treasurer, et al., plaintiffs (including county school boards of Wake, Durham, Johnston, Buncombe, Edgecombe and Lenoir Counties) requested a declaration that certain payments to state administrative agencies are civil penalties which, under the North Carolina Constitution, must be paid to the schools. On December 14, 2001, the trial court granted summary judgment in favor of the plaintiffs, holding that the funds are civil fines or penalties required by the North Carolina Constitution to be paid to the public schools in the county where the violation occurred. The case was appealed, and the decision of the North Carolina Court of Appeals was substantially favorable to the State. The North Carolina Supreme Court reversed, holding that a majority of the funds in dispute are civil penalties required to be paid for the benefit of public schools. On August 8, 2008 the trial court entered judgment in favor of the plaintiffs for approximately $750 million. However, the court acknowledged that the judicial branch cannot force the State to satisfy the judgment and that any decision to do so must be made by the General Assembly.

North Carolina and seven other southeastern states are members of the Southeast Interstate Low-level Radioactive Waste Management Compact (the “Compact”) to plan and develop a site for the disposal of low-level radioactive waste generated in the member states. The responsibility for developing the first disposal site was assigned to North Carolina, which, according to certain members of the Compact and the commission which administers the Compact (the “Commission”), did not actively pursue the permitting and development of the proposed site. After North Carolina withdrew from the Compact in 1999, the other members of the Compact and the Commission demanded the repayment, with interest, of $80 million expended on the permitting, plus $10 million of future lost income, interest and attorneys’ fees. On August 5, 2002 the Commission and four member states filed a motion requesting the United States Supreme Court to hear the claim, which the Court accepted on June 16, 2003. North Carolina’s motion to dismiss was denied on November 17, 2003. The Court appointed a Special Master, which heard oral arguments on motions filed by both sides and issued his “Preliminary Report” and his “Second Report” on April 2, 2009. In his reports, the Special Master recommended, among other things, that the Court dismiss the claims seeking monetary sanctions and enter partial summary judgment finding that North Carolina did not breach the Compact by withdrawing. North Carolina and the plaintiffs filed a total of nine exceptions to the Special Master’s reports. The United States Supreme Court rejected all nine exceptions, adopting the recommendations of the Special Master, with the effect of terminating the plaintiffs’ statutory and contractual claims. However, in rejecting North Carolina’s exceptions to the Special Master’s report, the Court allowed further briefing and argument on the plaintiffs’ equitable claims (unjust enrichment, promissory estoppel, and money had and received).

In Goldston v. State of North Carolina, plaintiffs demanded the return to the Highway Trust Fund of funds transferred from the Highway Trust Fund to the General Fund to balance the state budget. The suit alleges that the transfer of funds constitutes a borrowing by the State and is unlawful and unconstitutional. The plaintiffs requested a declaration that taxes collected for the Highway Trust Fund cannot be used for other purposes. The trial court granted summary judgment for the State on all issues. On September 20, 2005, the North Carolina Court of Appeals upheld the trial court’s order. The North Carolina Supreme Court, in an opinion filed December 15, 2006, reversed the Court of Appeals, concluding that plaintiffs have standing to pursue their claims. The trial court, on March 7, 2008, again granted summary judgment in favor of the State, and again

 

D-45


Table of Contents

plaintiffs appealed. The North Carolina Court of Appeals, on September 15, 2009, held that, while the transfer by the General Assembly of $125 million from the Highway Trust Fund to the General Fund was permitted, the transfer of $80 million by the Governor exceeded his constitutional authority under the North Carolina Constitution. Both sides filed respective notices of appeal with the North Carolina Supreme Court. The plaintiffs’ notice of appeal was dismissed by the court on January 28, 2010. As of this writing, the court is yet to rule on the State’s notice of appeal.

On April 20, 2006, the State filed a motion for declaratory order against defendants Philip Morris, Inc., R.J. Reynolds Tobacco Company, and Lorillard Tobacco Company, in State of North Carolina v. Philip Morris, USA Inc., et al. The motion sought a declaration, among other things, that in 2003, North Carolina continuously had a “Qualifying Statute” in full force and effect and “diligently enforced” its provisions throughout that year in accordance with the Tobacco Master Settlement Agreement (the “MSA”), the agreement by which the largest tobacco companies make payments to various states, including North Carolina, to compensate them for smoking-related illnesses amongst their citizens. If North Carolina were not to prevail in the diligent enforcement litigation, the State may be unable to recover a portion of that year’s MSA payment. On December 4, 2006, the trial court allowed the defendants’ motion to compel arbitration of these issues. The North Carolina Court of Appeals affirmed the trial court. On March 19, 2009, the State’s appeal to the North Carolina Supreme Court was denied. The State will therefore now be required to participate in a national arbitration process with the tobacco companies and 47 other MSA states and territories, the courts of which have considered similar litigation and concluded that the issues must be arbitrated.

The Adviser believes that the information summarized above describes the more significant matters relating to the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund. The sources of the information are the official statements of the Department of the State Treasurer of North Carolina, financial reports from the Office of the State Controller of North Carolina, other publicly available documents and oral statements from various State agencies and individuals. The Adviser has not independently verified any of the information contained in the official statements, other publicly available documents, or oral statements from various State agencies.

South Carolina

The South Carolina (State) Constitution mandates a balanced budget. If a deficit appears likely, the State Budget and Control Board, composed of the Governor, the State Treasurer, the State Comptroller General, the Chairman of the Senate Finance Committee, and the Chairman of the House Ways and Means Committee, must take action to avoid a fiscal year-end deficit. If it is determined that a fiscal year has ended with an operating deficit, the State Constitution requires that monies appropriated from the Capital Reserve Fund must be reduced to the extent necessary and applied to the year end operating deficit before withdrawing monies from the General Reserve Fund for such purpose.

By statute, the State General Assembly has provided that if monies in the Capital Reserve Fund and General Reserve Fund are insufficient to balance the Budgetary General Fund, the State Budget and Control Board is authorized to borrow the amount needed to balance the Budgetary General Fund from any department of State government with a surplus to the credit of the State department on hand in the Office of the State Treasurer. Amounts borrowed must be repaid from the General Fund no later than June 30th of the following fiscal year.

The State Constitution limits annual increases in the State appropriations to the average growth rate of the economy of the State and annual increases in the number of State employees to the average growth rate of the population of the State; provided, however, that these two limitations are subject to suspension for any one fiscal year by a special vote in each House of the General Assembly.

The State Constitution requires a General Reserve Fund that equals three percent of General Fund revenue for the latest completed fiscal year. Funds may be withdrawn from the General Reserve Fund only for the purpose of covering operating deficits of State government. The State Constitution also requires a Capital Reserve Fund equal to two percent of General Fund revenue for the latest completed fiscal year.

 

D-46


Table of Contents

 

The State Constitution requires that the General Assembly provide that, if revenue forecasts before March 1 project that revenues for the current fiscal year will be less than expenditures authorized by appropriation for the current fiscal year, the current fiscal year’s appropriation to the Capital Reserve Fund shall first be reduced to the extent necessary before any reduction is made in operating appropriations.

After March 1, monies from the Capital Reserve Fund may be appropriated by a special vote of the General Assembly to finance previously authorized capital improvement bond projects, to retire principal or interest on bonds previously issued, and to pay for capital improvements or other nonrecurring purposes. Monies in the Capital Reserve Fund not appropriated or any appropriation for a particular project or item that has been reduced due to application of the monies to a year-end deficit must lapse and be credited to the General Fund.

Fiscal Year Ended June 30, 2009

The original revenue estimate adopted by the Board of Economic Advisors for the State’s Budgetary General Fund for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2009 was $7,246.4 million, and the appropriation act estimate as enacted by the General Assembly was $6,735.7 million. On July 21, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $7,106.4 million, a decrease of $140.0 million, and a 1.9% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on August 12, 2008 reduced the State’s Capital Reserve Fund of $133.2 million as required by the State Constitution and the State’s fiscal year 2008-09 Appropriation Act. Reduction of the Capital Reserve Fund reduces appropriations to the Capital Reserve Fund to the extent necessary to avoid mandatory reductions in operating appropriations. Additionally, the State Budget and Control Board mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 3% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso and approved a 3% reduction of the Local Government Fund. Additionally, certain agency appropriations lapsed as a result of suspension of a provision that, in some years, has allowed agencies to carry forward to the next fiscal year up to 10% of their unexpended appropriations. This provision was automatically suspended for the fiscal year because of reduction of the Capital Reserve Fund. On October 8, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,692.4 million, a decrease of $414 million, and a 7.6% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate.

On October 20, 2008, the South Carolina General Assembly reconvened to amend the general appropriations act for fiscal year 2008-09, enact targeted reductions in General Fund appropriations, suspend actions of the State Budget and Control Board described above that mandated the across board reduction of General Fund appropriations and the reduction to the Local Government Fund, and validate and confirm use of the Capital Reserve Fund to offset the revenue shortfall for fiscal year 2008-09. These amendments to the 2008-09 appropriations act totaled expenditure reductions of $621.1 million, consisting of $487.9 million in targeted reductions and the $133.2 million reduction of the Capital Reserve Fund described above. On November 7, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,557.4 million, a decrease of $135.0 million, and a 9.5% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. On December 10, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,327.7 million, a decrease of $229.7 million, and a 12.7% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on December 11, 2008 mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 7% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso and approved a 7% reduction of the Local Government Fund. On March 11, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,263.3 million, a decrease of $64.4 million, and a 13.6% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on March 18, 2009 mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 2% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso. On June 11, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,171.3 million, a decrease of $92.0 million, and a 14.8% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-2009 estimate.

 

D-47


Table of Contents

 

On August 14, 2009, the state’s Comptroller General reported that the state completed the 2008-09 fiscal year with a net budgetary general fund deficit of $339.5 million. Accordingly, $133.2 million of the 2008-09 Capital Reserve Fund and $108.1 million of the General Reserve Fund were applied to offset the budgetary deficit. Despite these offsets, the state completed the 2008-09 fiscal year with a $98.2 million net budgetary general fund deficit following application of reserves. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on September 3, 2009, acting pursuant to the South Carolina Code of Laws, approved a borrowing in the amount of $98,216,617, the amount needed to balance the budgetary General Fund. The borrowing was effected from surplus funds that are held in the General Deposit Account within the custody of the State Treasurer, and must be repaid on or before June 30, 2011 from the fiscal year 2010-11 General Fund.

The General Reserve Fund balance at the beginning of fiscal year 2008-09 was $95.1 million and was increased during fiscal year 2008-09 by $13.0 million. Following a $108.1 million withdrawal at year-end 2009, net of an increase during fiscal year 2009-10 by $63.9 million, the reserve was funded at $63.9 million during fiscal year 2009-10. In accordance with the State Constitution, the General Reserve Fund must be restored within three years to its full-funding amount of 3% of the State’s Budgetary General Fund revenues for the latest completed fiscal year. The State’s audited Comprehensive Annual Financial Report for fiscal year ended June 30, 2009 can be found at http://www.cg.state.sc.us.

Fiscal Year Ending June 30, 2010

The original revenue estimate adopted by the Board of Economic Advisors for the State’s budgetary General Fund for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2010 was $6,070.6 million, and the appropriation act estimate as enacted by the General Assembly was $5,714.0 million. On June 11, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,950.6 million, a decrease of $120.0 million, and a 2.0% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on June 29, 2009 reduced the State’s Capital Reserve Fund of $120.0 million (effective July 1, 2009 with subsequent ratification at its next meeting) as required by the State Constitution and the State’s fiscal year 2009-10 Appropriation Act. On July 16, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,742.3 million, a decrease of $208.3 million, and a 5.4% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on September 3, 2009 reduced the remaining balance in the Capital Reserve Fund of $7.8 million and mandated an across the board reduction of general fund appropriations of 4.04% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso or statue. On November 10, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,620.0 million, a decrease of $122.3 million, and a 7.4% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on

December 15, 2009 mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 5.0% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso or statute. The action taken by the State Budget and Control Board on December 15, 2009 included consideration for the $122.3 million revenue revision adopted by the Board of Economic Advisors on November 10, 2009, and an additional $98.2 million necessary to avoid a year-end deficit in fiscal year 2009-10 that arose as a consequence of the previously described deficiency in the budgetary General Fund when closing the books on June 30, 2009. On April 14, 2010, the Board of Economic Advisors revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,559.9 million, a decrease of $60.1 million, and a 8.4% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate.

Through June 30, 2010, total General Fund revenue collections year to date exceeded the fiscal year 2009-10 revised revenue plan adopted on April 14, 2010 by $134.7 million or 2.5%, and were under prior year collections for the same period by $337.1 million or 5.8%.

State’s Economy

The State’s economy was predominantly dependent on agriculture until well into the 20th century; thereafter, manufacturing became the leading contributor to the gross state product. Since the 1950’s, the State’s economy has undergone a gradual transition to other activities.

 

D-48


Table of Contents

 

Real Gross Domestic Product. At December 31, 2008, principal contributors to the State’s gross domestic product were the trade, transportation and utilities industries (20%), and manufacturing sectors (18%), followed by government (15%). During the years 2003-2008, the fastest growing contributors to the State’s gross domestic product were the information industry (8.3% average annual growth), followed by professional and business services (4.9%) and education and health services (3.9%). Manufacturing declined over the period by 2.6% in South Carolina, while growing slightly in both the southeast by 0.4% and the nation by 1.2%. The State’s total gross domestic product grew at an average annual growth rate of 1.0% (v. 2.0% for southeastern states, and 2.0% for the nation) from 2003-2008.

Employment. The State’s unemployment rate in June, 2010 was 10.7%, as compared to 9.2% for the southeastern states and 9.5% for the nation. Over the past several years, the State’s unemployment rates have trended higher than the unemployment rates of other southeastern states and the nation. Largest contributors to the state’s unemployment rate are declines in manufacturing jobs and growth in the labor force. While the State’s economy is generating jobs, not enough jobs have been created to address the expanding labor force. The State’s nonagricultural employment increased 4.9% from 2003-2008, to 1.89 million by December, 2008. Strongest job growth through the period 2003-2008 occurred in the government sector (38,700, 1.2%), followed by education and health services (30,400, 3.2%), professional and business services industry (22,900 jobs, 2.3% average annual growth), trade, transportation and utilities (18,000, 1.0%), leisure and hospitality (13,500, 1.4%), and financial activities (13,200, 2.7%). During the same period, the State’s manufacturing sector declined by 67,600 jobs (2.6%).

Per Capita Income. In 2008, the State’s per capita income increased to $31,854 or 2.4% year over year, compared to an increase of 2.3% for the southeast and 2.9% for the nation. The State’s per capita income was 80.2% of the national (compared to 80.5% in 2007) and 89.0% of the southeast (compared to 88.9% in 2007) per capita income.

Population. The State’s population estimate at December 31, 2008 was almost 4.5 million. The State’s rate of growth in population was 10th fastest in the United States in 2008.

Economic Development. For the calendar year 2008, the South Carolina Department of Commerce reported $4.170 billion in new capital investments that are expected to create about 18,993 new jobs. Over the past three years, 29 percent of those jobs were in the State’s rural areas. Additional details and other information regarding economic development efforts may be found at the South Carolina Department of Commerce website, located at http://www.sccommerce.com.

Litigation

There is presently no litigation challenging the validity of any general obligation debt issued or proposed to be issued by the State. The Attorney General of the State advises that, except as described immediately below, there is neither threatened nor, to his knowledge pending, any litigation which would have any material adverse effect upon the revenues of the State.

Anonymous Taxpayer vs. South Carolina Department of Revenue. A separate anonymous taxpayer protest seeks a refund of income taxes pursuant to the statute providing for tax credits related to Economic Impact Zones. The Department of Revenue denied the refund, and the matter came before an Administrative Law Court. The Administrative Law Court allowed a $2,112,640 refund for tax year 1995, but denied the $15,323,257 refund request for tax years 1997 and 1998. Both the taxpayer and DOR are seeking judicial review by the Circuit Court.

Abbeville County School District, et. al. v. State of South Carolina. This action was originally brought seeking declaratory and injunctive relief on behalf of certain school districts, taxpayers, and individuals alleging that the State’s method of funding primary and secondary public education violated several provisions of State and federal law. The lower court dismissed the complaint on all counts. The South Carolina Supreme Court

 

D-49


Table of Contents

affirmed the lower court’s dismissal of all but one of the counts, but reversed the lower court’s dismissal of a claim arising under the education clause of the South Carolina Constitution. Specifically, the South Carolina Supreme Court held that the South Carolina Constitution requires the State to provide the opportunity for each child within the State to receive a minimally adequate education. Finding that the complaint stated a claim under this provision, the South Carolina Supreme Court remanded the case for further proceedings. Following the remand, the plaintiffs requested leave to amend their complaint in this action to add a claim for damages for past actions or omissions of the State. The Court accepted the amended complaint. The suit also contains requests for declaratory and injunctive relief that could result in the State’s providing additional monies for public education and, possibly, for other purposes. On December 29, 2005, the Court issued an order concluding that the instructional facilities in the school districts are safe and adequate to provide the opportunity for a minimally adequate education; that the State’s curriculum standards at the minimum encompass the knowledge and skills necessary to satisfy the definition for a minimally adequate education; that the State’s system of teacher licensure is sufficient to ensure at least minimally competent teachers to provide instruction consistent with the curriculum standards; that inputs into the educational system, except for the funding of early childhood intervention programs, are sufficient to satisfy the constitutional requirement; that the constitutional requirement of adequate funding is not met by the State as a result of its failure to adequately fund early childhood intervention programs; and that the students in the school districts are denied the opportunity to receive minimally adequate education because of the lack of effective and adequately funded early childhood intervention programs designed to address the impact of poverty on their educational abilities and achievements. Motions for reconsideration were denied in June, 2007, and the parties have since appealed to the South Carolina Supreme Court. The Supreme Court heard the case on June 25, 2008, but has yet to render a decision. There is no official estimate of the fiscal impact of any remedial action that will be necessitated by the findings of the Court; however, the General Assembly made provision in the 2006-07 Appropriation Act for $23 million to be expended for the purpose of initially addressing the court’s findings, and further provided for establishment of a committee to study and determine steps necessary to address those findings in future years.

Dean v. South Carolina Department of Public Safety. This class action suit seeks back wages including overtime pay for all hours during which State troopers were on call and during which they were on special duty assignments. The suit seeks payment under the Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA) and the State Wage Payment Act. The court has ruled that this is an “opt in” class, so that it includes all troopers in the State except for the less than 200 who opted out. Questions to be resolved in the case include whether a two or three year statute of limitations applies and whether the period of recovery may be extended back to 1986, the year the FLSA became applicable to the states. The court has ruled that treble damages would not apply to the State, but it has not ruled on the statute of limitations issue. Extensive discovery is proceeding. Settlement discussions have been undertaken. Under the Plaintiffs’ theory of the case, in the event of a loss to the State, the amount could exceed $12 million. The State is vigorously defending this case, but cannot predict its outcome.

Ahrens et al. v. The South Carolina Retirement System and the State of South Carolina. This case is a class action case alleging that provisions in Act No. 153 of the Acts and Joint Resolutions of the General Assembly for the year 2005 (Act No. 153) requiring working retirees in the South Carolina Retirement System (SCRS) to make employee contributions are unconstitutional and illegal. A circuit court judge has certified the class in this case and issued an order on the merits granting the Plaintiffs relief based on the equitable theory of estoppel. The circuit court denied all other claims for relief made by the plaintiffs, including their contract causes of action. The Retirement Systems and the State of South Carolina have appealed the circuit court’s order and the matter is pending before the South Carolina Supreme Court. As of March 31, 2010, the Retirement Systems had collected approximately $44.5 million in the form of retirement contributions from members of the South Carolina Retirement System who retired prior to July 1, 2005, separated from employment and returned to work. If the Plaintiffs were to ultimately prevail, most, if not all of these contributions could be refunded to the

members and no future contributions could be collected from many, if not all, of the class members. The Retirement Systems and the State of South Carolina believe their appeal is meritorious and is vigorously contesting these claims and pursuing all appellate options.

 

D-50


Table of Contents

 

Arnold et al. v. the South Carolina Police Officers Retirement System, the South Carolina Retirement System and the State of South Carolina. This case is a class action case filed on August 9, 2005, alleging that provisions in Act No. 153 requiring working retirees in the Police Officers Retirement System (PORS) to make employee contributions are unconstitutional and illegal. A circuit court judge has certified the class in this case and issued an order on the merits in the matter granting the plaintiffs relief based on the equitable theory of estoppel. The circuit court denied all other claims for relief made by the plaintiffs, including their contract causes of action. The PORS and the State of South Carolina have appealed the circuit court’s order and the matter is pending before the South Carolina Supreme Court. As of March 31, 2010, the Retirement Systems had collected approximately $14.3 million in the form of retirement contributions from members of the Police Officers Retirement System who retired prior to July 1, 2005 and returned to work. If the Plaintiffs were to ultimately prevail, most, if not all, of these contributions could be refunded to the members and no future contributions could be collected from many, if not all, of the class members. The Police Officers Retirement System and the State of South Carolina believe their appeal is meritorious and is vigorously contesting contesting these claims and pursuing all appellate options.

Other Litigation. Certain other legal actions to which the State is a party are discussed in the Notes to the State’s audited financial statements available at www.cg.state.sc.us. Those discussions accurately portray the status and potential impact of such actions, based upon information currently available to the State.

Miscellaneous

South Carolina Lottery. In November, 2000, the State’s electorate approved an amendment to the State Constitution to permit the implementation of a lottery. The amendment was adopted by the South Carolina General Assembly during its 2001 legislative session, and the lottery became operational in January, 2002. As adopted, revised Article XVII, Section 7 of the State Constitution permits lotteries and requires lottery revenues to be applied first to pay all operating expenses and prizes, with the remainder credited to a separate Education Lottery Account in the State Treasury. All account proceeds, including earnings from the investments thereof, which are required to be credited to the Education Lottery Account, must be allocated by the General Assembly only for educational purposes.

The latest information available indicates a total of $270 million net of operating expenses has been transferred to the Education Lottery Account. Monies in the Education Lottery Account must be used to supplement and not supplant existing funds for education including pre-school, elementary, high school, technical and higher teaming programs, scholarships, tuition assistance, libraries, endowed chairs at various institutions of higher learning, and acquisition of school buses.

The Adviser believes that the information summarized above describes some of the more significant matters relating to the South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund. The sources of the information are the official statements of issuers located in South Carolina, other publicly available documents, or oral statements from various State agencies. The Adviser has not independently verified any of the information contained in the official statements, other publicly available documents, or oral statements from various State agencies.

Virginia

Debt may be issued by or on behalf of the Commonwealth of Virginia (“Virginia” or the “Commonwealth”) in accordance with the provisions of Article X, Section 9 of the Virginia Constitution. Virginia counties, cities and towns may issue debt pursuant to the provisions of Article VII, Section 10 of the Virginia Constitution and the Public Finance Act of 1991 (Virginia Code Sections 15.2-2600 through 15.2-2663). Private activity bonds may be issued by various special purpose authorities, including industrial development authorities created pursuant to the Industrial Development and Revenue Bond Act (Virginia Code Sections 15.2-4900 through 15.2-4920).

 

D-51


Table of Contents

 

Section 9 of Article X of the Virginia Constitution provides for the issuance of (a) debt to which the Commonwealth’s full faith and credit is pledged (“general obligation debt”) and (b) debt of the Commonwealth not secured by the full faith and credit of the Commonwealth, but which may be supported by and paid from Commonwealth tax collections and other sources of revenue. The Commonwealth and its localities may also enter into leases and contracts that are not “debt” for constitutional purposes, even though they are classified as long-term indebtedness on the issuer’s financial statements. The repayment of such obligations is contingent upon the receipt of periodic appropriations of funds for debt service by the applicable governing body.

The Virginia Constitution authorizes general obligation debt for various purposes, and imposes certain restrictions on the amount of general obligation debt that may be issued by the Commonwealth and, in some cases, makes such debt subject to approval in a state-wide referendum election. The restrictions applicable to general obligation debt of the Commonwealth do not apply to obligations for which the full faith and credit of the Commonwealth is not pledged towards the payment of such indebtedness. Such bonds may be paid in whole or in part from revenues received as appropriations by the General Assembly from general tax and other state revenues or solely from revenues derived from revenue-producing undertakings.

The Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund invests in debt obligations issued by Virginia local governments in addition to indebtedness of the Commonwealth itself. Local government units in the Commonwealth are comprised of counties, incorporated cities, and incorporated towns. The Commonwealth is unique in that cities and counties are independent of each other and their land areas generally do not overlap for governmental jurisdiction purposes. Cities and counties each levy and collect their own taxes and provide their own services. Towns may also levy and collect taxes for town purposes but their residents remain subject to county taxes.

Local governments are authorized under the Virginia Constitution to issue general obligation debt and debt secured by revenues of a revenue-producing undertaking. Generally, debt issued by a county pledging the full faith and credit of the county is subject to voter approval in a referendum election. The aggregate amount of general obligation debt issued by a county is not otherwise limited as to amount. Debt pledging the full faith and credit of a town or city is generally subject to a state constitutional limit on the outstanding amount of such debt equal to 10 percent of the assessed valuation of the real estate subject to taxation in the city or town. Revenue bonds payable from revenues derived from a revenue-producing undertaking and certain lease or installment sale obligations that are subject to appropriation each year by the governing body of the locality are not generally subject to such limit or voter approval requirements.

The primary sources of money available to localities to pay debt service on general obligation bonds are real and personal property taxes, sales tax and business license taxes. Virginia Code Section 15.2-2659, known as the “state aid intercept provision” provides security for the repayment of general obligation indebtedness by a locality. That statute creates a mechanism by which the Commonwealth may withhold appropriated funds payable from the state to any locality for application toward any overdue debt service on general obligation bonds issued by such locality.

Numerous obligations are also issued by industrial development authorities, redevelopment and housing authorities, water and sewer authorities, community development authorities, utility service districts and other issuers created and empowered to issue bonds by Virginia statute. Such bonds are usually payable from the revenues derived from a particular undertaking and are not secured by a pledge of the faith and credit of the Commonwealth or any county, city or town. These issuers do not typically have taxing power.

The General Fund is the chief operating fund of Virginia. The General Fund of the Commonwealth derives its revenues primarily from five major taxes imposed by the Commonwealth. Such taxes are imposed in accordance with statutory and regulatory requirements upon: (1) individual and fiduciary income; (2) corporation and other business income; (3) state sales and use transactions; (4) deeds, contracts, wills and lawsuits; and (5) premiums of insurance companies. Financial accounting (under generally accepted accounting principles, or

 

D-52


Table of Contents

GAAP) and budgetary accounting (on a cash basis) is maintained on a June 30 fiscal year basis by the Commonwealth and its cities, towns and counties. The most recent audited financial statements available for the Commonwealth are for the fiscal year that ended on June 30, 2009.

The General Fund balance decreased by $1.4 billion in fiscal year 2009, a 62.9 percent reduction from fiscal year 2008. Fiscal year 2009 state revenue collections, including taxes, were $14,876,226. However, overall tax revenues decreased by 8.9 percent from fiscal year 2008 to fiscal year 2009. Individual and fiduciary income tax revenues decreased by 6.3 percent and there was a 5.6 percent decline in state sales and use taxes, a 19.8 percent decrease in corporate income taxes, a 5.2 percent decline in Public Service Corporation taxes and a 27.9 percent decrease in other taxes including deeds, contracts, wills and lawsuits, alcoholic beverage sales, tobacco products, estate and other taxes. Overall revenue and non-tax revenues decreased by 9.0 percent and by 11.5 percent, respectively. Overall expenditures declined by 3.8 percent in fiscal year 2009, compared to a 6.6 percent increase in fiscal year 2008. Individual and family service expenditures decreased by $243.0 million, or 5.7 percent, and education expenditures increased by $223.2 million, or 2.9 percent. General government expenditures decreased $120.5 million or 6.7 percent.

General Fund revenues were less than expenditures and other uses by $1.4 billion in fiscal year 2009. The General Fund unreserved balance on a budgetary basis decreased by $930.9 million, or 85.3 percent, from fiscal year 2008 to fiscal year 2009 while reserved General Fund balances decreased by $465.4 million or 41.3 percent during the same period. Total revenues and total expenditures decreased by 9.0 percent and 3.8 percent, respectively. Transfers to the General Fund increased by 4.7 percent while transfers out decreased by 19.9 percent.

Of the $823.5 million General Fund balance at June 30, 2009, $575.1 million was reserved for the Revenue Stabilization Fund. During fiscal year 2009, a $490 million withdrawal was made from the Revenue Stabilization Fund. The Revenue Stabilization Fund is segregated from the General Fund and can only be used for constitutionally authorized purposes. Virginia law directs that the Revenue Stabilization Fund be included as a component of the General Fund only for financial reporting purposes.

Under the provisions of Article X, Section 8 of the Constitution of Virginia, and based on fiscal year 2009 revenue collections, no deposits are required during fiscal year 2011. Section 2.2-1829(b) of the Code of Virginia, requires that if certain revenue criteria are met, then an additional deposit to the Revenue Stabilization Fund equal to at least one-half the mandatory deposit must be included in the Governor’s budget. The Code further requires that any such additional deposits to the Revenue Stabilization Fund shall be included in the Governor’s budget recommendations only if the estimate of General Fund revenues for the fiscal year in which the deposit is to be made is at least 5 percent greater than the actual General Fund revenues for the immediately preceding fiscal year. These conditions were not met for fiscal year 2009. The Constitutional maximum for the Revenue Stabilization Fund remains at $1.4 billion for fiscal year 2010.

On May 17, 2010, Virginia’s biennial budget was approved by the governor and enacted as the 2010-12 Appropriations Act (“Budget Bill”). The Budget Bill became effective on July 1, 2010 and includes projected General Fund revenue of $15,383,733,704 for the fiscal year ending on June 30, 2011 with appropriations of $15,376,985,189 and projected General Fund revenues of $16,017,286,924 for the fiscal year ending on June 30, 2012 with appropriations of $16,021,156,894. The biennial budget included, among other things, a $50,000,000 deposit to the Revenue Stabilization Fund scheduled for the fiscal year ending on June 30, 2012.

Virginia’s 2011-2012 biennial budget (enacted in 2010) projected total General Fund revenue available for appropriation to equal $31,401,020,628 billion for fiscal years 2011 and 2012. Lower revenue collections previously resulted in adjustments and recalibrations to the fiscal year 2009 budget. However, Virginia’s Secretary of Finance released a statement on behalf of the Governor on July 14, 2010 which indicates that the Governor anticipates a revenue surplus at the end of the 2010 fiscal year on June 30 estimated to be at least $220 million, attributable primarily to individual and corporate and business tax receipts. The final figure for the

 

D-53


Table of Contents

surplus will be made official in August after final adjustments to the financial information are made. The Governor also noted that although this is a positive development, local government finances remain under stress.

Over $5 billion of federal stimulus funds has been allocated to Virginia under the American Reinvestment and Recovery Act (ARRA). Legislation effective in April 2009 allowed appropriation and spending of ARRA funding by the Virginia General Assembly. The General Assembly has distributed allocations and appropriations across several fiscal years. Approximately 30 percent of the total available AARA funds were allocated to fiscal year 2009, with the remainder either being allocated specifically to fiscal year 2010 or remaining to be allocated to either fiscal year 2010 or 2011.

The Commonwealth’s 2009 estimated population of 7,882,590 was approximately 2.6 percent of the United States’ total. With 39,594 square miles of land area, its 2008 population density was estimated to be 196.22 persons per square mile, compared with 95.66 persons per square mile for the United States. According to the U.S. Department of Commerce, Bureau of Economic Analysis, in 2008, the Commonwealth had per capita personal income of $42,876, which was greater than the national average of $39,371, the eighth highest state average nationally and the highest of the Southeast region. According to the U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics, Virginia had a preliminary unemployment rate of 7.2 percent as of June 2009 compared to 9.5 percent nationally, making the Commonwealth the state with the ninth lowest unemployment rate in June 2009. Furthermore, Virginia had a preliminary seasonally adjusted unemployment rate of 7.0 percent as of June 2010 compared to 9.5 nationally.

As of June 30, 2010, Virginia’s bond rating is the best available from the leading ratings agencies at (Aaa/AAA/AAA from Moody’s, Standard & Poor’s, and Fitch Ratings, respectively) for long-term general obligation bonds and has maintained its top rating for such bonds for a period of time believed to be longer than any other state.

The sources of the information described above include the statutes and constitutional provisions referenced, to which reference is made for more detailed information, and official statements of the Commonwealth and other publicly available documents. The Adviser has not independently verified any of the information contained in these official statements or documents.

 

D-54


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX E — LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

Legacy Columbia funds are funds that were branded Columbia or Columbia Acorn prior to Sept. 27, 2010.

 

ColumbiaSM Acorn® Fund    Columbia Large Cap Index Fund
ColumbiaSM Acorn International®    Columbia Large Cap Value Fund
ColumbiaSM Acorn International Select®    Columbia Liberty Fund
ColumbiaSM Acorn Select®    Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio
ColumbiaSM Acorn USA®    Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund    Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II    Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio
Columbia Balanced Fund    Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund
Columbia Blended Equity Fund    Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund
Columbia Bond Fund    Columbia Marsico Global Fund
Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Marsico Growth Fund
Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund    Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund
Columbia Connecticut Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
   Columbia Maryland Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund   

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund    Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund    Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio
Columbia Convertible Securities Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund
Columbia Core Bond Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund
Columbia Corporate Income Fund (formerly known as Columbia Income Fund)    Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund
Columbia Disciplined Value Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund
Columbia Dividend Income Fund    Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund
Columbia Emerging Markets Fund   

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund   

Columbia New York Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Federal Securities Fund    Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund
Columbia Georgia Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
  

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Global Value Fund   

Columbia Oregon Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Greater China Fund    Columbia Overseas Value Fund
Columbia High Income Fund    Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund
Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund    Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund
Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund   

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund    Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Select Opportunities Fund
Columbia International Bond Fund    Columbia Select Small Cap Fund
Columbia International Growth Fund    Columbia Short Term Bond Fund
Columbia International Stock Fund    Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund
Columbia International Value Fund    Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund
Columbia Large Cap Core Fund    Columbia Small Cap Core Fund
Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I
Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

 

E-1


Table of Contents
Columbia Small Cap Index Fund    Columbia Technology Fund
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I    Columbia Thermostat Fund®
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II    Columbia Total Return Bond Fund
Columbia South Carolina Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
   Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Columbia Strategic Income Fund    Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund
Columbia Strategic Investor Fund    Columbia Virginia Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund    Columbia World Equity Fund

 

E-2


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX F — LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

Legacy RiverSource funds include RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds, funds renamed effective Sept. 27, 2010 to bear the Columbia brand, and certain other funds. Prior fund names are noted in parenthesis.

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund)

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund)

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Tax-Exempt Bond Fund)

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Asia Pacific Fund)

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Bond Fund)

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Equity Income Fund)

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Dividend Opportunity Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Emerging Markets Bond Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund)

Columbia Equity Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Equity Value Fund)

Columbia European Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle European Equity Fund)

Columbia Floating Rate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Floating Rate Fund)

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Frontier Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Global Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Global Bond Fund)

Columbia Global Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Global Equity Fund)

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund (RiverSource Global Extended Alpha Fund)

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc. (formerly known as RiverSource Government Money Market Fund, Inc.)

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource High Yield Bond Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Basic Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund II (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Moderate Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund III (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Enhanced Income Fund)

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Opportunities Fund)

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Inflation Protected Securities Fund)

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Equity Fund)

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Limited Duration Bond Fund)

Columbia Marsico Flexible Capital Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund)

Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Cash Management Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners International Select Value Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund)

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund)

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Recovery and Infrastructure Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2010 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2015 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2020 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2025 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2030 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2035 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2040 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2045 Fund)

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Large-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund (formerly known as Seligman Global Technology Fund)

Columbia Short-Term Cash Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund)

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Strategic Allocation Fund)

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund (formerly known as RiverSource U.S. Government Mortgage Fund)

RiverSource Balanced Fund

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

Seligman California Municipal High Yield Series

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

Seligman National Municipal Class

Seligman New York Municipal Class

Seligman TargETFund 2015

Seligman TargETFund 2025

Seligman TargETFund 2035

Seligman TargETFund 2045

Seligman TargETFund Core

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

Appendix C– Pro forma financial statements

NARRATIVE DESCRIPTION OF THE PRO FORMA EFFECTS OF THE REORGANIZATIONS

The unaudited pro forma information set forth below for the twelve month periods ended on the dates indicated is intended to present supplemental data as if the reorganizations of one or more funds (each a “Selling Fund” and together, the “Selling Funds”) into other corresponding funds (each a “Buying Fund” and together, the “Buying Funds”), as noted in Table 1 below (the “Reorganizations”), had occurred as of the beginning of the period (unless otherwise noted). No Reorganization is contingent upon any other Reorganization. Information has not been presented for any Reorganizations involving a Selling Fund the net assets of which were less than 10% of the net assets of the corresponding Buying Fund as of October 6, 2010.

Table 1 – Reorganizations

 

Selling Fund

  

Buying Fund

  

Period Ended

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

   Columbia Contrarian Core Fund    September 30, 2010

Seligman Capital Fund

   Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund    August 31, 2010

Seligman Growth Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund    September 30, 2010

Basis of Combination

In August 2010, the Boards of Directors of the Selling Funds approved an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “Plan of Reorganization”) pursuant to which, subject to shareholder approval, each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding Buying Fund (“Reorganization Shares”) and each Buying Fund will assume all of the liabilities of the corresponding Selling Fund. Selling Fund shareholders will receive the class of Reorganization Shares indicated in Table 2 below. Each Buying Fund will issue Reorganization Shares with an aggregate net asset value equal to the aggregate value of the assets that it receives from the corresponding Selling Fund, less the liabilities it assumes from the corresponding Selling Fund. All Reorganization Shares delivered to the Selling Funds will be delivered at net asset value without a sales load, commission or other similar fee being imposed. Immediately following the transfer, the Reorganization Shares received by each Selling Fund attributable to each class thereof will be distributed pro rata, on what is expected to be a tax-free basis for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to the shareholders of such class of the Selling Fund in proportion to their holdings of shares of the Selling Fund.

Table 2 – Reorganization Shares

 

Selling Fund Share Class

       

Reorganization Share Class

Class A

   ®    Class A

Class B

   ®    Class B

Class C

   ®    Class C

Class I

   ®    Class I

Class R

   ®    Class R

Class R4

   ®    Class R4

Class R5

   ®    Class R5

Note that Class R2 of certain Selling Funds was redesignated as Class R, effective September 7, 2010. Class R of such Selling Funds will reorganize into Class R of the corresponding Buying Fund, as applicable.

Under the terms of the Plan of Reorganization, each Reorganization will be accounted for by the method of accounting for tax-free mergers of investment companies. Following the Reorganizations, the Buying Funds will be the accounting survivors. In accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, the historical cost of investment securities will be carried forward to the surviving funds and the results of operations for

 

C-1


Table of Contents

pre-Reorganization periods will not be restated. The costs of the Reorganizations, current estimates of which are set forth in Table 5 below, will be borne by the Selling Funds and the Buying Funds (each a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”) up to the amount of the anticipated reduction in expenses borne by that Fund over the first year following the Reorganization. Any Reorganization expenses otherwise allocable to a Fund that are in excess of that limitation will be borne by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (“Columbia Management”) or its affiliates and not by any other Fund. If a Reorganization is not consummated, Columbia Management or its affiliates will bear the costs associated with that Reorganization. The pro forma information provided herein should be read in conjunction with the audited financial statements of the Funds included in their most recent annual reports and, as applicable, the unaudited financial statements of the Funds included in their most recent semi-annual reports, in each case dated as indicated in Table 3 below.

Table 3 – Shareholder Reports and Statements of Additional Information Dates

 

Fund

   Annual Report    Semi-Annual
Report

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   9/30/2010    N/A

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   5/31/2010    N/A

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   8/31/2010    N/A

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

   12/31/2009    6/30/2010

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   9/30/2010    N/A

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

   12/31/2009    6/30/2010

Table 4 below presents, as of the date indicated, the net assets of each Fund.

Table 4 – Selling Funds and Buying Funds Net Assets

 

Fund

   Net Assets      As-Of Date

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 590,491,572       September 30, 2010

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 531,059,186       September 30, 2010

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 1,092,860,028       August 31, 2010

Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 213,640,293       August 31, 2010

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 1,219,220,273       September 30, 2010

Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 1,566,093,438       September 30, 2010

Table 5 presents the estimated Reorganization costs (exclusive of any transaction costs associated with any portfolio realignment); the net assets as of the date indicated in Table 4 above of each Buying Fund assuming the indicated Reorganizations occurred on that date, after accounting for the estimated Reorganization costs to be borne by the Buying Fund and the corresponding Selling Fund; and, on a pro forma basis, the estimated relative increases or decreases in combined operating expenses that would have been incurred during the one-year period ended on the date indicated in Table 4 above. The pro forma increases and decreases represent the differences between (i) the combined expenses actually charged to the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund during the period and (ii) the expenses that would have been charged to the combined assets of the Buying and Selling Funds if the reorganizations and other contractual changes had occurred at the beginning of the year.

The unaudited pro forma information set forth in Table 5 below reflects adjustments made to expenses for differences in contractual rates, duplicate services and other services that would not have occurred if the Reorganizations had taken place on the first day of the period described in Table 1 above. The pro forma information has been derived from the books and records of the Funds utilized in calculating daily net asset value for the Funds and has been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, which require the use of management estimates. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

 

Table 5 – Estimated Reorganization Costs, Combined Fund Net Assets and Pro Forma Increases or Decreases in Expenses (1)

 

Proposal 1

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

    $ 97,618   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

    $ 1,121,453,140   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (2)

   ($ 685,608

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 37,637

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 115,837

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 13,015

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 40,720

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 18,403

Transfer agency fees (3)

   ($ 182,185

Other (5)

   ($ 7,277
     (Increase) Decrease  

Waiver and/or reimbursement of fund expenses (6)

    $ 736,650   

 

Proposal 2

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

    $ 143,752   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

    $ 1,306,356,569   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (7)

   ($ 236,100

Plan administration fee (8)

   ($ 25,357

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 35,979

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 145,095

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 21,856

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 45,960

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 34,383

Transfer agency fees (3)

   ($ 248,696

Other (5)

   ($ 3,763

 

Proposal 4

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

    $ 731,740   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

    $ 2,784,581,971   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (2)

    $ 961,948   

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 37,348

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 141,553

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 22,981

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 51,036

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 45,206

Transfer agency fees (3)

    $ 854,742   

Other (5)

   ($ 29,459
     (Increase) Decrease  

Waiver and/or reimbursement of fund expenses (6)

    $ 690,901   

 

(1) See “Fees and Expenses” in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus for more information.

 

C-3


Table of Contents
(2) Management fees are composed of an advisory fee and an administration fee and have been adjusted to reflect the contractual rates charged to the Buying Fund, proposed to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval.
(3) Adjustment reflects changes in contractual rates.
(4) Adjustment reflects changes in contractual rates. This service will not be separately charged and will be provided as a component of administration services.
(5) Adjustment reflects the elimination of duplicate services.
(6) Adjustment reflects the aggregate (increase) decrease in expense reimbursements and/or waivers by Columbia Management and its affiliates.
(7) Management fees are composed of an advisory fee and an administration fee and have been adjusted to reflect the contractual rates charged to the Buying Fund, proposed to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(8) Adjustment reflects the elimination of this Selling Fund expense, which is not charged to the Buying Fund.

Pursuant to an Investment Management Services Agreement with Columbia Management, each Fund pays a monthly management fee to Columbia Management based on the average daily net assets of the Fund, at the annual rates shown in Table 6 below. The Board of Trustees of each Buying Fund has approved a new Investment Management Services Agreement (“New Agreement”) for each of the Buying Funds, under which management fees would be paid to Columbia Management based on the average daily net assets of the Fund, at the annual rates shown below.

The New Agreements for Columbia Contrarian Core Fund and Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund are each subject to approval by shareholders of such Buying Funds.

Table 6 – Investment Management Fees

 

Fund

  

Assets (billions)

   Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Buying Fund -
Proposed)
 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.700

0.650

0.600

0.550

0.530

0.510


   

 

 

 

 

 

0.710

0.665

0.620

0.570

0.560

0.540


RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.0

Next $1.0

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.730

0.705

0.680

0.655

0.630

0.600


    N/A   

 

C-4


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Assets (billions)

   Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Buying Fund -
Proposed)
 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Over $1.5

    

 

 

 

0.820

0.750

0.720

0.670


   

 

 

 

0.760

0.715

0.670

0.620


Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

  

First $1.0

Next $1.0

Over $2.0

    

 

 

0.805

0.765

0.715


    N/A   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

  

First $0.25

Next $0.25

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.700

0.575

0.450

0.450

0.450

0.450

0.450


   

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.710

0.710

0.665

0.620

0.570

0.560

0.540


Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

  

First $1.0

Next $1.0

Over $2.0

    

 

 

0.655

0.615

0.565


    N/A   

Pursuant to an Administrative Services Agreement with Columbia Management or Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (“Ameriprise Financial”), as indicated in Table 7 below, each Fund’s administrator (“Administrator”) provides most administrative services to the Fund. For all services provided under the Administrative Services Agreement, each Fund pays its Administrator a monthly administration fee as a percentage of the Fund’s average daily net assets, at the annual rates shown in Table 7 below. The Board of Trustees of each Buying Fund has approved a new Administrative Services Agreement for the Fund under which administration fees would be paid to Columbia Management based on the average daily net assets of the Fund, at the annual rates shown below.

Table 7 – Administration Fees

 

Fund

   Administrator   

Assets (billions)

   Annual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Buying
Fund - New)
 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   Columbia
Management
  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.067

0.067

0.067

0.067

0.067


   

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   Ameriprise
Financial
  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


    N/A   

 

C-5


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Administrator   

Assets (billions)

   Annual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Current)
    Anual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Buying
Fund - New)
 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   Columbia
Management
  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.000

0.000

0.000

0.000

0.000


   

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


Seligman Capital Fund (Selling Fund)

   Ameriprise
Financial
  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


    N/A   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund (Buying Fund)

   Columbia
Management
  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.050

0.050

0.050

0.050

0.050


   

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


Seligman Growth Fund (Selling Fund)

   Ameriprise
Financial
  

First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


    N/A   

Ameriprise Financial provides accounting services as part of its Administrative Services Agreement. State Street Bank and Trust Company provides accounting services to the Funds administered by Columbia Management.

Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., an affiliate of Columbia Management, is the transfer agent for each Fund. Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., an affiliate of Columbia Management, is the distributor for each Fund.

No significant accounting policies will change as the result of the proposed Reorganizations.

The estimated costs of the Reorganizations shown in Table 5 above do not reflect any brokerage commissions incurred by a Fund in connection with any portfolio realignment. Columbia Management expects that, subsequent to the Reorganizations, there may be some portfolio realignment of the Buying Funds (of securities acquired from the Selling Funds). However, Columbia Management expects that any such portfolio realignment will not result in any significant increase in a Buying Fund’s portfolio turnover rate, relative to its historical portfolio turnover rates. Columbia Management also does not expect any incremental trading costs to be significant.

Federal Income Taxes

Please see “Tax Status of the Reorganizations” in the Prospectus/Proxy Statement for a discussion of the tax effects of each Reorganization.

 

C-6


Table of Contents

 

It is each Fund’s policy to comply with the requirements of the Internal Revenue Code applicable to regulated investment companies, and to distribute all of its investment company taxable income to shareholders. After the Reorganizations, the Buying Funds intend to continue to qualify as regulated investment companies.

 

C-7


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

COMBINED PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS

[], 2010

This is a brief overview of the reorganization proposed for your fund. We encourage you to read the full text of the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus.

Q: Why am I being asked to vote?

Funds are required to obtain shareholder approval for certain kinds of changes, like the reorganizations proposed in the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus. As a shareholder of one of the above-listed funds, you are being asked to vote on a reorganization involving your fund. In addition, the trustees of certain of the funds listed above have nominated candidates for election and re-election as trustees. Shareholders of those funds are entitled to vote in these elections.

Q: What is a fund reorganization?

A fund reorganization results in one fund transferring all of its assets and liabilities to another fund in exchange for shares of such fund. Once completed, shareholders of the selling fund will hold shares of the buying fund.

Q: Is my vote important?

Absolutely! While the Board of Trustees (the “Board”) of each fund listed above has reviewed the proposed reorganizations and recommends that you approve them, these transactions generally cannot go forward without the approval of shareholders. Similarly, while the Board of certain funds has nominated candidates for trustee, you have the right to vote to elect the trustees that oversee your fund. Until a fund is sure that a quorum has been reached, it will continue to contact shareholders asking them to vote.

Q: On what am I being asked to vote?

Shareholders are being asked to vote on the reorganization (a “Reorganization”) of one or more funds (each a “Selling Fund” and together, the “Selling Funds”) into other corresponding funds (each a “Buying Fund” and together, the “Buying Funds”) as noted in the table below:

 

Selling Fund

  

Buying Fund

Columbia Blended Equity Fund    Columbia Large Cap Core Fund
Columbia Select Opportunities Fund    Columbia Strategic Investor Fund
Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund    Columbia Strategic Investor Fund
Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I
Columbia Disciplined Value Fund    Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly, RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

If the Reorganization of your Selling Fund is approved by shareholders and the other closing conditions are met, your shares of the Selling Fund will, in effect, be converted into shares of a corresponding class of the corresponding Buying Fund with the same aggregate net asset value as that of your Selling Fund shares at the time of the Reorganization. (Selling Funds and Buying Funds are referred to individually or collectively as a “Fund” or the “Funds,” respectively, in the attached documents.) While the aggregate net asset value of your shares will not change as a result of the Reorganization, the number of shares you hold may differ based on each Fund’s net asset value.

In addition, shareholders of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II are being asked to vote for the election or re-election of sixteen nominees as trustees of the Fund.


Table of Contents

 

We encourage you to read the full text of the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus to obtain a more detailed understanding of the issues relating to each proposed Reorganization and, as applicable, of the nominees for election to your Fund’s Board.

Q: Why are the Reorganizations being proposed?

On May 1, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly known as RiverSource Investments, LLC), the Funds’ investment manager (“Columbia Management”), acquired the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC and certain of its affiliated companies from Bank of America, N.A. (the “Transaction”). In connection with the Transaction, Columbia Management became the investment manager of the Columbia-branded funds (the “Columbia Fund Complex”), in addition to the funds that were then branded as RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds (the “RiverSource Fund Complex” and, together with the Columbia Fund Complex, the “Combined Fund Complex”).

The proposed Reorganizations are among the reorganizations recommended by Columbia Management following the Transaction. Columbia Management’s overall goal in proposing the reorganizations is twofold. First, by combining Columbia-, RiverSource-, Seligman- and Threadneedle-branded funds with generally similar investment objectives, strategies and policies, each combined investment portfolio will be larger, which tends to lead to greater efficiency. Second, by streamlining the product offering of the Combined Fund Complex, management, administration, distribution and other resources can be focused more effectively on a smaller group of funds. The Reorganization of each Selling Fund into the corresponding Buying Fund will enable shareholders of each Selling Fund to invest in a larger, potentially more efficient portfolio while continuing to pursue a similar investment strategy.

Q: Will there be any changes to the options or services associated with my account as a result of the mergers?

Account-level features and options such as dividend distributions, dividend diversification, automatic investment plans, systematic withdrawals and dollar cost averaging will automatically carry over from accounts in Selling Funds to accounts in the corresponding Buying Fund.

Q: Are there costs or tax consequences of the Reorganizations?

You will not pay any sales charge in connection with the Reorganizations. Reorganization costs will be allocated to each Fund only to the extent they are expected to be offset by the anticipated reduction in expenses borne by the Fund’s shareholders during the first year following the Reorganization. Each Reorganization is expected to be tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Accordingly, no gain or loss is expected to be recognized by the Selling Fund or its shareholders as a direct result of a Reorganization. A portion, which may be substantial, of the portfolio assets of a Buying or Selling Fund may be sold before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. Such sales will result in such Fund incurring transaction costs and may result in a taxable distribution of gains to shareholders.

Q: If approved, when will the Reorganizations happen?

The Reorganizations will take place as soon as practicable following shareholder approval, and are expected to close before the end of the second quarter of 2011.

Q: Why have the Boards of certain Funds nominated candidates for election to those Boards?

Following the Transaction, described above, the boards of directors/trustees of the RiverSource Fund Complex (the “Columbia RiverSource Board”) and the boards of trustees of the Columbia Fund Complex had ongoing discussions regarding a potential consolidated board of directors/trustees to oversee all or a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. In September 2010, these discussions culminated in an agreement between the Columbia RiverSource Board and the current board of trustees of certain of the trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex (the “Columbia Nations Board”) to have a consolidated board of directors/trustees for a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. Specifically, they agreed that the RiverSource Fund Complex and the portion of the Columbia Fund Complex overseen by the Columbia Nations Board should be overseen by a consolidated board of directors/trustees. In this regard, the Columbia Nations Board and Columbia RiverSource Board each determined that the consolidation would enhance the oversight of a larger fund family and should achieve cost efficiencies for fund shareholders.

 

-2-


Table of Contents

 

In order to effect the consolidation, [the Governance Committees of the Columbia Nations Board and the Columbia RiverSource Board, along with each full Board, have nominated individuals] listed under Proposal 5 of the combined proxy statement/prospectus for election to the Columbia Nations Board and the Columbia RiverSource Board, each to hold office for an indefinite term. Information about each nominee is set forth in this combined proxy statement/prospectus under Proposal 5.

Q: How does my Board recommend that I vote?

After careful consideration, your Board recommends that you vote FOR the Reorganization of your Selling Fund and FOR each nominee for election as trustee of your Fund, if applicable.

Q: How can I vote?

You can vote in one of four ways:

 

 

By telephone ([[phone number]])

 

 

By internet ([[internet url]])

 

 

By mail (using the enclosed postage prepaid envelope)

 

 

In person at the shareholder meeting scheduled to occur in [[XXXX location]] on [[MM/DD/YY]]

The deadline for voting by telephone or internet is [[MM/DD/YY]]. We encourage you to vote as soon as possible to avoid the cost of additional solicitation efforts. Please refer to the enclosed proxy card for instructions for voting by telephone, internet or mail.

Q: Will I be notified of the results of the vote?

Please check www.columbiamanagement.com for updated information on the Reorganizations including voting results. The final voting results for each proposal also will be included in each fund’s next report to shareholders following the meeting.

Q: Whom should I call if I have questions?

If you have questions about any of the proposals described in the combined proxy statement/prospectus or about voting procedures, please call the Selling Funds’ proxy solicitor, Computershare Fund Services, toll free at 800-708-7953.

 

-3-


Table of Contents

 

NOTICE OF A JOINT SPECIAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS

Columbia Funds Series Trust

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Columbia Funds Series Trust I

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

To be held [], 2011

A Joint Special Meeting of Shareholders (the “Meeting”) of each of the Funds listed above (each a “Selling Fund”) will be held at [] [a.m./p.m.] on [] 2011, at [] in the [] room on the [] floor. At the Meeting, shareholders will consider the following proposal with respect to their Selling Fund:

 

1. To approve the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “Agreement”) by and among Columbia Funds Series Trust, on behalf of its Columbia Large Cap Core Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II series, Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I and Columbia Disciplined Value Fund series, RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., on behalf of its Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly, RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund) series, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, pursuant to which each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the corresponding buying fund, as indicated below (each a “Buying Fund”) in exchange for shares of a corresponding class of the Buying Fund and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. The Buying Fund shares will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

Shareholders of each Selling Fund will vote separately on the relevant proposal, as shown below.

 

Selling Fund

  

Buying Fund

   Proposal #  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

             1           

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

     2           

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

     2           

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II    

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

     3           

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund*

(formerly, RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

     4           

 

* The Board of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. has approved the redomiciling of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, a series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., into a newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust that has also been named Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (the “Redomiciling”). The Redomiciling is subject to approval by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. If the Redomiciling is approved by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, it is expected that the Redomiciling will occur prior to the Reorganizations, in which case the Buying Fund will be the newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust. If the Redomiciling has not been completed prior to the closing of the Reorganization, the Buying Fund will be the existing series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc.

 

2. At the Meeting, shareholders of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II also will vote to elect certain nominees as trustees (Proposal 5).

Shareholders of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II will vote on Proposal 5 together as a single class with shareholders of each other series of Columbia Funds Series Trust.

 

-1-


Table of Contents

 

Please take some time to read the enclosed combined proxy statement/prospectus. It discusses these proposals in more detail. If you were a shareholder on December 17, 2010, you may vote at the Meeting or at any adjournment or postponement of the Meeting. You are welcome to attend the Meeting in person. If you cannot attend in person, please vote by mail, telephone or internet. Just follow the instructions on the enclosed proxy card. If you have questions, please call the Selling Funds’ proxy solicitor toll free at []. It is important that you vote. The Board of Trustees of each Selling Fund recommends that you vote FOR its Reorganization and, if applicable, FOR each nominee for trustee.

By order of the Boards of Trustees

 

LOGO

Scott R. Plummer, Secretary

[], 2010

 

-2-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

COMBINED PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS

Dated [], 2010

This document is a proxy statement for each Selling Fund (as defined below) and a prospectus for each Buying Fund (as defined below). The address and telephone number of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund is c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, and 800.345.6611. This combined proxy statement/prospectus and the enclosed proxy card were first mailed to shareholders of each Selling Fund beginning on or about January [], 2011. This combined proxy statement/prospectus contains information you should know before voting on the following proposals with respect to your Selling Fund, as indicated below:

 

Proposal

            

To be voted on by
shareholders of:

1. To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Blended Equity Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust, on behalf of its Columbia Large Cap Core Fund series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, the Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Selling Fund

    Buying Fund   

Class A

          g           Class A   

Class C

          g           Class C   

Class Z

          g           Class Z   

2. To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund series (each a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Strategic Investor Fund series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Selling Funds

    Buying Fund   

Class A

          g           Class A   

Class C

          g           Class C   

Class R

          g           Class R   

Class Z

          g           Class Z   

 

-1-


Table of Contents

Proposal

            

To be voted on by
shareholders of:

3. To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among Columbia Funds Series Trust, on behalf of its Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II series (a “Selling Fund”), Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I series (a “Buying Fund”), each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, the Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Selling Fund

    Buying Fund   

Class A

          g           Class A   

Class B

          g           Class B   

Class C

          g           Class C   

Class Z

          g           Class Z   

4. To approve an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization by and among Columbia Funds Series Trust I, on behalf of its Columbia Disciplined Value Fund series (a “Selling Fund”), RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., on behalf of its Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly, RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund) series (a “Buying Fund”)*, each an open-end registered investment company, certain other registered investment companies and Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. Under the agreement, each Selling Fund will transfer that portion of its assets attributable to each class of its shares (in aggregate, all of its assets) to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding class of the Buying Fund (as indicated below) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund. Shares of each class of the Buying Fund will be distributed proportionately to shareholders of the relevant class of the Selling Fund.

   Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

Selling Fund

    Buying Fund   

Class A

          g           Class A   

Class B

          g           Class B   

Class C

          g           Class C   

Class T

          g           Class T   

Class Z

          g           Class Z   
        

*    TheBoard of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. has approved the redomiciling of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, a series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., into a newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust that has also been named Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (the “Redomiciling”). The Redomiciling is subject to approval by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. If the Redomiciling is approved by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, it is expected that the Redomiciling will occur prior to the Reorganizations, in which case the Buying Fund will be the newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust. If the Redomiciling has not been completed prior to the closing of the Reorganization, the Buying Fund will be the existing series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. Except as otherwise noted, information contained herein relating to the Buying Fund applies to both the existing series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. and the newly-created series of RiverSource Series Trust.

  

5. To elect trustees to the Board of Trustees of Columbia Funds Series Trust, each to hold office for an indefinite term.

   Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

 

-2-


Table of Contents

 

The proposals will be considered by shareholders who owned shares of the Selling Funds on December 17, 2010 at a joint special meeting of shareholders (the “Meeting”) that will be held at [] [[a.m./p.m.]] on [], 2011, at [] in the [] room on the [] floor. Each of the Selling Funds and the Buying Funds (each a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”) is a registered open-end management investment company (or a series thereof). Please read this combined proxy statement/prospectus and keep it for future reference.

Although the Board of Trustees (the “Board”) of each Selling Fund* recommends that shareholders approve the reorganization of the Selling Fund into the corresponding Buying Fund (each a “Reorganization”), the Reorganization of each Selling Fund is not conditioned upon the Reorganization of any other Selling Fund. Accordingly, if shareholders of one Selling Fund approve its Reorganization, but shareholders of a second Selling Fund do not approve the second Selling Fund’s Reorganization, it is expected that the Reorganization of the first Selling Fund will take place as described in this combined proxy statement/prospectus. If shareholders of any Selling Fund fail to approve its Reorganization, the Board of such Selling Fund will consider what other actions, if any, may be appropriate.

Shareholders of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II will vote together as a single class with the shareholders of the other series of the trust of which that Fund is a series, if any. Thus, if applicable, the outcome of Proposal 5 will depend in part on the votes of shareholders of those other series, which are being solicited separately.

 

* References to the Board of a Fund refer to the Board of the corporation or trust, of which the Fund is a series.

How Each Reorganization Will Work

 

 

Each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of such Buying Fund (“Reorganization Shares”) and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the Selling Fund’s liabilities.

 

 

Each Buying Fund will issue Reorganization Shares with an aggregate net asset value equal to the aggregate value of the assets that it receives from the corresponding Selling Fund, less the liabilities it assumes from the corresponding Selling Fund. Each class of Reorganization Shares will be distributed to the shareholders of the corresponding class of the Selling Fund in liquidation of the Selling Fund in proportion to their holdings in such class of the Selling Fund. For example, holders of Class A shares of a Selling Fund will receive Class A shares of the corresponding Buying Fund with the same aggregate net asset value as their Selling Fund Class A shares at the time of the Reorganization. You will not pay any sales charge in connection with the receipt or distribution of Reorganization Shares. If you already have a Buying Fund account with exactly the same registration as your Selling Fund account, your Reorganization Shares typically will be added to that account.

 

 

Reorganization costs will be allocated to each Fund only to the extent they are expected to be offset by the anticipated reduction in expenses borne by the Fund’s shareholders during the first year following the Reorganization. Each Reorganization is expected to be tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Accordingly, no gain or loss is expected to be recognized by the Selling Fund or its shareholders as a direct result of a Reorganization. A portion, which may be substantial, of the portfolio assets of a Buying or Selling Fund may be sold before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. Such sales will result in such Fund incurring transaction costs and may result in a taxable distribution of gains to shareholders.

Where to Get More Information

The following documents have been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and are incorporated into this combined proxy statement/prospectus by reference:

 

 

The Statement of Additional Information of the Buying Funds relating to the Reorganizations (the “Merger SAI”), dated [], 2010;

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

 

 

the prospectuses of Columbia Blended Equity Fund, dated August 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

-3-


Table of Contents

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Blended Equity Fund, dated August 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Blended Equity Fund for the year ended March 31, 2010;

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

 

 

the prospectuses of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, dated February 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, dated February 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund for the year ended September 30, 2009, and the unaudited financial statements included in the Semiannual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund for the period ended March 31, 2010;

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

 

 

the prospectuses of Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, dated August 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, dated August 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund for the year ended March 31, 2010;

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

 

 

the prospectuses of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, dated August 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, dated August 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund for the year ended March 31, 2010; and

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

 

 

the prospectuses of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, dated July 1, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, dated September 27, 2010, as supplemented to date;

 

 

the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements included in the Annual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II for the year ended February 28, 2010 and the unaudited financial statements included in the Semiannual Report to Shareholders of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II for the period ended August 31, 2010.

For a free copy of any of the documents listed above and/or to ask questions about this combined proxy statement/prospectus, please call your Selling Fund’s proxy solicitor toll free at [].

Each of the Funds is subject to the information requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (the “Exchange Act”) and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, (the “1940 Act”) and files reports, proxy materials and other information with the SEC. These reports, proxy materials and other information can be inspected and copied at the Public Reference Room maintained by the SEC. Copies may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request at publicinfo@sec.gov, or by writing to the Public Reference Branch of the SEC, Office of Consumer Affairs and Information Services, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549-0102. In addition, copies of these documents may be viewed online or downloaded from the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

Please note that investments in the Funds are not bank deposits, are not federally insured, are not guaranteed by any bank or government agency and may lose value. There is no assurance that any Fund will achieve its investment objectives.

As with all open-end mutual funds, the SEC has not approved or disapproved these securities or passed on the adequacy of this combined proxy statement/prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 

-4-


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

Section A — Reorganization Proposals

     7   

Summary

     7   

How Each Reorganization Will Work

     7   

Tax Consequences

     7   

Fees and Expenses

     8   

Proposal 1. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund.

     9   

Proposal 2. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of each of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

     12   

Proposal 3. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

     16   

Proposal 4. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

     19   

Proposal 1. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

     23   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     23   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     23   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     23   

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

     24   

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     26   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     27   

Performance

     29   

Proposal 2. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of each of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

     32   

Comparison of each Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     32   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     32   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     32   

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

     34   

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     35   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     35   

Performance

     37   

Proposal 3. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

     41   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     41   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     41   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     41   

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

     42   

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     44   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     44   

Performance

     46   

Proposal 4. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

     49   

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

     49   

Comparison of Investment Objectives

     49   

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

     49   

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

     51   

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     52   

Comparison of Principal Risks

     53   

Performance

     54   

Additional Information about Each Reorganization

     58   

Terms of the Reorganizations

     58   

Conditions to Closing Each Reorganization

     58   

Termination of the Agreement

     59   

 

-5-


Table of Contents
     Page  

Tax Status of the Reorganizations

     59   

Reasons for the Proposed Reorganizations and Board Deliberations

     62   

Board Recommendation and Required Vote

     65   

Section B — Board Proposal

     66   

Proposal 5 — Election of Trustees

     66   

Information Regarding the Non-Interested Nominees

     67   

Information Regarding the Interested Nominees

     69   

Nominees’ Beneficial Ownership of Shares of the Board Election Fund

     70   

Current Status of Trustees

     70   

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

     70   

Current Committees of the Columbia Nations Board

     71   

Nominee Qualifications

     73   

Procedures for Communications to the Columbia Nations Board

     74   

Executive Officers of CFST

     74   

Remuneration for Trustees and Officers

     74   

Required Vote and Recommendation

     75   

Section C — Proxy Voting and Shareholder Meeting Information

     76   

Section D — Capitalization, Ownership of Fund Shares and Financial Highlights

     79   

Capitalization of Selling Funds and Buying Funds

     79   

Ownership of Selling Fund and Buying Fund Shares

     81   

Financial Highlights of the Buying Funds

     83   

Exhibits

  

A. Costs of the Reorganizations

     A-1   

B. Additional Information Applicable to the Buying Funds

     B-1   

C. Comparison of Organizational Documents

     C-1   

D. Executive Officer and Director Information

     D-1   

E. Trustee Compensation

     E-1   

F. Share Ownership of Nominees

     F-1   

G. Columbia Funds Series Trust’s Governance Committee Charter

     G-1   

 

-6-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION A — REORGANIZATION PROPOSALS

The following information describes each proposed Reorganization.

SUMMARY

This combined proxy statement/prospectus is being used by each Selling Fund to solicit proxies to vote at a joint special meeting of shareholders. Shareholders of each Selling Fund will consider a proposal to approve the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “Agreement”) providing for the Reorganization of their Selling Fund into the corresponding Buying Fund.

The following is a summary. More complete information appears later in this proxy statement/prospectus. You should read the entire proxy statement/prospectus and the exhibits because they contain details that are not included in this summary.

How Each Reorganization Will Work

 

 

Each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for Reorganization Shares and the assumption by the corresponding Buying Fund of all of the Selling Fund’s liabilities.

 

 

Each Buying Fund will issue Reorganization Shares with an aggregate net asset value equal to the aggregate value of the assets that it receives from the corresponding Selling Fund, less the liabilities it assumes from the corresponding Selling Fund. Reorganization Shares of each class of each Buying Fund will be distributed to the shareholders of the corresponding class of the corresponding Selling Fund in proportion to their holdings of such class of such Selling Fund. For example, holders of Class A shares of a Selling Fund will receive Class A shares of the corresponding Buying Fund with the same aggregate net asset value as the aggregate net asset value of their Selling Fund Class A shares at the time of the Reorganization.

 

 

As part of the Reorganization of your Selling Fund, systematic transactions (such as bank authorizations and systematic payouts) currently set up for your Selling Fund account may be transferred to your new Buying Fund account. Please contact your financial intermediary for additional details.

 

 

No shareholders of any Selling Fund will pay any sales charge in connection with acquiring Reorganization Shares.

 

 

After a Reorganization is completed, Selling Fund shareholders will be shareholders of the corresponding Buying Fund, and the Selling Fund will be dissolved.

Tax Consequences

Each Reorganization is expected to be tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes and will not take place unless the Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund receive a satisfactory opinion of tax counsel substantially to the effect that it will be tax-free, as described in more detail in the section entitled “Tax Status of the Reorganizations.” Accordingly, no gain or loss is expected to be recognized by the Selling Fund or its shareholders as a direct result of a Reorganization. A portion, which may be substantial, of the portfolio assets of a Buying or Selling Fund may be sold before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. The actual tax effect of such sales will depend on the difference between the price at which such portfolio assets are sold and the tax basis in such assets of the Fund making the sale. Any capital gains recognized in those sales on a net basis, after reduction by any available capital losses, will be distributed to shareholders as capital gain dividends (to the extent of net realized long-term capital gains over net realized short-term capital losses) and/or ordinary dividends (to the extent of net realized short-term capital gains over net realized long-term capital losses) during or with respect to the year of sale, and such distributions will be taxable to shareholders. Additionally, because each Reorganization will end the tax year of the applicable Selling Fund, it will accelerate distributions to shareholders from the Selling Fund for its short tax year ending on the date of the Reorganization. Those tax year-end distributions will be taxable, and will include any distributable, but not previously distributed, capital gains resulting from portfolio turnover prior to consummation of the Reorganization. At any time prior to a Reorganization, a shareholder may redeem shares of a Selling Fund. This would likely result in the recognition of gain or loss by the shareholder for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If a shareholder holds Selling Fund shares in a non-taxable account, distributions and redemption proceeds with respect to those shares will not be taxable to the shareholder if those amounts remain in the non-taxable account.

The Selling Fund shareholders’ aggregate tax basis in the Reorganization Shares is expected to carry over from the shareholders’ Selling Fund shares, and the Selling Fund shareholders’ holding period in the Reorganization Shares is expected to include the shareholders’ holding period in the Selling Fund shares.

 

-7-


Table of Contents

 

For more information about the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganizations, see the section entitled “Tax Status of the Reorganizations.”

Fees and Expenses

The following tables describe the fees and expenses that you may pay if you buy and hold shares of a Fund.

Annual fund operating expense ratios are based on expenses incurred during each Fund’s most recently completed fiscal year, and are expressed as a percentage (expense ratio) of the Fund’s average net assets during the period. Pro forma expense ratios shown are based on each Fund’s average net assets over the applicable Buying Fund’s most recently completed fiscal year. As of the date of this combined proxy statement/prospectus, each Fund’s net assets may be lower or higher than the Fund’s average net assets over such period. In general, a Fund’s annual operating expense ratios will increase as the Fund’s assets decrease and will decrease as the Fund’s assets increase. Accordingly, each Fund’s annual operating expense ratios, if adjusted based on net assets as of the date of this combined proxy statement/prospectus, could be higher or lower than those shown in the tables below. The commitment by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (“Columbia Management”) and its affiliates to waive fees and/or to reimburse expenses for the Buying Funds noted below may limit the effect that any decrease in such a Buying Fund’s net assets will have on its annual net operating expense ratios in the current fiscal year.

Certain Selling Funds have voluntary fee waiver and/or expense reimbursement arrangements. For more information, see the Selling Funds’ prospectuses.

The fees and expenses below exclude one-time costs of the Reorganization. The costs of each Reorganization expected to be borne by each Fund are set forth in Exhibit A.

 

-8-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 1. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by approximately $0.07 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

     Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Current)

(Selling Fund)

      

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      1.00 %(c)      N/A   
     Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Current and Pro Forma)

(Buying Fund)

      

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      1.00 %(c)      N/A   

 

(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of your investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment):

 

     Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Current)

(Selling Fund)

      

Management fees(1)

     0.90     0.90     0.90

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.16     0.16     0.16
                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.31     2.06     1.06
      Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Current)

(Buying Fund)

      

Management fees(3)

     0.74     0.74     0.74

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.17     0.17     0.17
                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.16     1.91     0.91
      Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Pro Forma)

(Buying Fund)

      

Management fees(4)

     0.73     0.73     0.73

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.18     0.18     0.18
                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses(5)

     1.16     1.91     0.91

 

-9-


Table of Contents

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.75% and an administration fee of 0.15%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates, expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(3) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.68% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.74% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.57% and an administration fee of 0.17%).
(4) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.67% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.73% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.56% and an administration fee of 0.17%).
(5) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed, on an annualized basis, 1.16% for Class A shares, 1.91% for Class C shares and 0.91% for Class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until June 30, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions your costs would be:

 

     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Current)

(Selling Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 701       $ 966       $ 1,252       $ 2,063   

Class C

   $ 309       $ 646       $ 1,108       $ 2,390   

Class Z

   $ 108       $ 337       $ 585       $ 1,294   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Current)

(Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 686       $ 922       $ 1,177       $ 1,903   

Class C

   $ 294       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,233   

Class Z

   $ 93       $ 290       $ 504       $ 1,120   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Pro Forma)

(Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 686       $ 922       $ 1,177       $ 1,903   

Class C

   $ 294       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,233   

Class Z

   $ 93       $ 290       $ 504       $ 1,120   

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

-10-


Table of Contents

 

     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Current)

(Selling Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 209       $ 646       $ 1,108       $ 2,390   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Current)

(Buying Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 194       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,233   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Pro Forma)

(Buying Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 194       $ 600       $ 1,032       $ 2,233   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average  Value
of the Fund’s Portfolio

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

     73%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   165%

 

-11-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 2. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of each of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

If the Reorganizations occur, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to each Selling Fund, which will reduce Columbia Select Opportunities Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganizations by less than $0.01 per share, and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by approximately $0.07 per share, based on each Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

     Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

      

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      1.00 %(c)      N/A

 

     Class A     Class C     Class R      Class Z  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

         

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      1.00 %(c)      N/A         N/A   

 

     Class A     Class C     Class R      Class Z  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

         

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A         N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 %(b)      1.00 %(c)      N/A         N/A   

 

(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of your investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment):

 

     Class A     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

      

Management fees(1)

     0.90     0.90     0.90

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.19     0.19     0.19
                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.34     2.09     1.09

 

     Class A     Class C     Class R     Class Z  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

        

Management fees(3)

     0.80     0.80     0.80     0.80

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.34     0.34     0.34     0.34
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.39     2.14     1.64     1.14

 

-12-


Table of Contents
     Class A     Class C     Class R     Class Z  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Management fees(4)

     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.30     0.30     0.30     0.30
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.30     2.05     1.55     1.05

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(5)

     -0.04     -0.04     -0.04     -0.04
                                

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.26     2.01     1.51     1.01

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.75% and an administration fee of 0.15%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(3) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.65% and an administration fee of 0.15%.
(4) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.69% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would be 0.73% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.58% and an administration fee of 0.15%) and Total annual Fund operating expenses would be 1.28% for Class A shares, 2.03% for Class C shares, 1.53% for Class R shares, and 1.03% for Class Z shares.
(5) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed, on an annualized basis, 1.26% for Class A shares, 2.01% for Class C shares, 1.51% for Class R shares and 1.01% for class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until December 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

The number of Reorganizations that occur will affect the Total annual Fund operating expenses of the Buying Fund on a pro forma combined basis after the Reorganizations. The tables below present the pro forma combined Total annual Fund operating expenses of the Buying Fund assuming in each case that (1) certain, but not all, of the Reorganizations are consummated or (2) that all of the Reorganizations are consummated. Specifically, the first table shows the pro forma combined Total annual Fund operating expenses of the Buying Fund assuming the combination of Reorganizations that results in the highest possible Total annual Fund operating expenses, [[the Reorganization of only Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund]], and the second table shows the pro forma combined Total annual Fund operating expenses of the Buying Fund assuming the combination of Reorganizations that results in the lowest possible Total annual Fund operating expenses, the Reorganization of all of the Selling Funds.

 

     Class A     Class C     Class R     Class Z  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma – Highest) (Buying Fund)

        

Management fees(1)

     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.29     0.29     0.29     0.29
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.29     2.04     1.54     1.04

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(3)

     -0.03     -0.03     -0.03     -0.03
                                

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.26     2.01     1.51     1.01

 

     Class A     Class C     Class R     Class Z  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma – Lowest/All Reorganizations) (Buying Fund)

        

Management fees(4)

     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     0.50     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.26     0.26     0.26     0.26
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(5)

     1.26     2.01     1.51     1.01

 

-13-


Table of Contents

 

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.69% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would be 0.73% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.58% and an administration fee of 0.15%) and Total annual Fund operating expenses would be 1.27% for Class A shares, 2.02% for Class C shares, 1.52% for Class R shares, and 1.02% for Class Z shares.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(3) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed, on an annualized basis, 1.26% for Class A shares, 2.01% for Class C shares, 1.51% for Class R shares, and 1.01% for Class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until December 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.
(4) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.69% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would be 0.73% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.58% and an administration fee of 0.15%) and Total annual Fund operating expenses would be 1.24% for Class A shares, 1.99% for Class C shares, 1.49% for Class R shares, and 0.99% for Class Z shares.
(5) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.26% for Class A shares, 2.01% for Class C shares, 1.51% for Class R shares, and 1.01% for Class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until December 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganizations. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions, your costs would be:

 

     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 704       $ 975       $ 1,267       $ 2,095   

Class C

   $ 312       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,421   

Class Z

   $ 111       $ 347       $ 601       $ 1,329   

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 708       $ 990       $ 1,292       $ 2,148   

Class C

   $ 317       $ 670       $ 1,149       $ 2,472   

Class R

   $ 167       $ 517       $ 892       $ 1,944   

Class Z

   $ 116       $ 362       $ 628       $ 1,386   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 696       $ 960       $ 1,243       $ 2,049   

Class C

   $ 304       $ 639       $ 1,100       $ 2,376   

Class R

   $ 154       $ 486       $ 841       $ 1,842   

Class Z

   $ 103       $ 330       $ 575       $ 1,279   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma – Highest) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 696       $ 958       $ 1,239       $ 2,039   

Class C

   $ 304       $ 637       $ 1,095       $ 2,366   

Class R

   $ 154       $ 484       $ 837       $ 1,832   

Class Z

   $ 103       $ 328       $ 571       $ 1,268   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma – Lowest/All Reorganizations) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 696       $ 952       $ 1,227       $ 2,010   

Class C

   $ 304       $ 630       $ 1,083       $ 2,338   

Class R

   $ 154       $ 477       $ 824       $ 1,802   

Class Z

   $ 103       $ 322       $ 558       $ 1,236   

 

-14-


Table of Contents

 

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund Growth Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 212       $ 655       $ 1,124       $ 2,421   

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 217       $ 670       $ 1,149       $ 2,472   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 204       $ 639       $ 1,100       $ 2,376   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma – Highest) (Buying Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 204       $ 637       $ 1,095       $ 2,366   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma – All Reorganizations) (Buying Fund)

           

Class C

   $ 204       $ 630       $ 1,083       $ 2,338   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example, affect a Fund’s performance. Columbia Management expects that Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund may experience significant portfolio turnover in connection with its Reorganization. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value
of the Fund’s Portfolio

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

   111%

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Selling Fund)

   164%

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

   117%

 

-15-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 3. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by approximately $0.03 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Current) (Selling Fund)

        

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of offering price at time of purchase)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A   
     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

        

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of offering price at time of purchase)

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      N/A   

 

(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of your investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy $1 million or more of Class A shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment):

 

     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Current) (Selling Fund)

        

Management fees(1)

     0.82     0.82     0.82     0.82

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.28     0.28     0.28     0.28
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.35     2.10     2.10     1.10
     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Management fees(3)

     0.85     0.85     0.85     0.85

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.23     0.23     0.23     0.23
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(4)

     1.33     2.08     2.08     1.08
     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class Z  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

        

Management fees(5)

     0.84     0.84     0.84     0.84

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.21     0.21     0.21     0.21
                                

Total annual Fund operating expenses(6)

     1.30     2.05     2.05     1.05

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.70% and an administration fee of 0.12%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.

 

-16-


Table of Contents
(3) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.77% and an administration fee of 0.08%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.85% (composed solely of an investment management services fee).
(4) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.35% for Class A shares, 2.10% for Class B shares, 2.10% for Class C shares and 1.10% for Class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until December 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.
(5) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.76% and an administration fee of 0.08%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management services fee rates expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.84% (composed solely of an investment management services fee).
(6) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.31% for Class A shares, 2.06% for Class B shares, 2.06% for Class C shares and 1.06% for Class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until December 31, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganizations. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions your costs would be:

 

     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 705       $ 978       $ 1,272       $ 2,105   

Class B

   $ 713       $ 958       $ 1,329       $ 2,240   

Class C

   $ 313       $ 658       $ 1,129       $ 2,431   

Class Z

   $ 112       $ 350       $ 606       $ 1,340   
     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 703       $ 972       $ 1,262       $ 2,084   

Class B

   $ 711       $ 952       $ 1,319       $ 2,219   

Class C

   $ 311       $ 652       $ 1,119       $ 2,410   

Class Z

   $ 110       $ 343       $ 595       $ 1,317   
     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 700       $ 963       $ 1,245       $ 2,050   

Class B

   $ 708       $ 942       $ 1,302       $ 2,184   

Class C

   $ 308       $ 642       $ 1,102       $ 2,376   

Class Z

   $ 107       $ 333       $ 578       $ 1,279   

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 213       $ 658       $ 1,129       $ 2,240   

Class C

   $ 213       $ 658       $ 1,129       $ 2,431   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

 

-17-


Table of Contents
     1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Class B

   $ 211       $ 652       $ 1,119       $ 2,219   

Class C

   $ 211       $ 652       $ 1,119       $ 2,410   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 208       $ 642       $ 1,102       $ 2,184   

Class C

   $ 208       $ 642       $ 1,102       $ 2,376   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value of the Fund’s  Portfolio

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

   105%

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

   149%

 

-18-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 4. Fees and Expenses. Reorganization of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

If the Reorganization occurs, certain Reorganization expenses, as described in Exhibit A, will be allocated to the Selling Fund, which will reduce the Selling Fund’s net asset value prior to the closing of the Reorganization by approximately $0.07 per share based on the Selling Fund’s shares outstanding as of September 30, 2010.

Current and Pro Forma Fees and Expenses for the Most Recent Fiscal Year

Shareholder Fees (fees paid directly from your investment)

 

     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class T     Class Z  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

          

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        5.75 %(a)      N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower

     1.00 %(b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      1.00 (e)      N/A   

 

     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class T     Class Z  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Current and Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

          

Maximum sales charge (load) imposed on purchases (as a percentage of offering price)

     5.75 %(a)      N/A        N/A        5.75 %(a)      N/A   

Maximum deferred sales charge (load) imposed on sales (as a percentage of net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower)

     1.00 (b)      5.00 %(c)      1.00 %(d)      1.00 (e)      N/A   

 

(a) This charge may be reduced depending on the total value of your investments in the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Threadneedle- and Seligman-branded funds (the “Combined Fund Complex”).
(b) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class A shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(c) This charge decreases over time.
(d) This charge applies to investors who buy Class C shares and redeem them within one year of purchase, with certain limited exceptions.
(e) This charge applies to investors who buy between $1 million and $50 million of Class T shares and redeem them within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase, with certain limited exceptions.

Annual Fund Operating Expenses (expenses that you pay each year as a percentage of the value of your investment):

 

     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class T     Class Z  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

          

Management fees(1)

     0.77     0.77     0.77     0.77     0.77

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25 %(3)      1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(2)

     0.23     0.23     0.23     0.53 %(4)      0.23
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.25     2.00     2.00     1.30     1.00

 

-19-


Table of Contents
     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class T     Class Z  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

          

Management fees(5)

     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees(4)

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(6)

     0.25     0.25     0.25     0.55     0.25
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses(7)

     1.25     2.00     2.00     1.30     1.00
     Class A     Class B     Class C     Class T     Class Z  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

          

Management fees(8)

     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75     0.75

Distribution and/or service (12b-1) fees

     0.25     1.00     1.00     0.00     0.00

Other expenses(6)

     0.18     0.18     0.18     0.48 %(4)      0.18
                                        

Total annual Fund operating expenses

     1.18     1.93     1.93     1.23     0.93

Fee waiver/expense reimbursement(7)

     (0.07 )%      (0.07 )%      (0.07 )%      (0.07 )%      (0.07 )% 
                                        

Net annual Fund operating expenses

     1.11     1.86     1.86     1.16     0.86

 

(1) Management fees are composed of an investment advisory fee of 0.70% and an administration fee of 0.067%.
(2) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010, and other changes to contractual fee rates, expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.
(3) The Fund may pay distribution and services fees up to a maximum of 0.35% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class A shares (composed of up to 0.10% for distribution and up to 0.25% for shareholder services) but currently limits such fees to an aggregate of not more than 0.25%.
(4) The Fund may pay shareholder service fees (which are included in other expenses) up to a maximum of 0.50% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (composed of up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.25% for administrative services), but currently limits such fees to an aggregate fee of not more than 0.30%.
(5) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.69% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates (including the elimination of a performance incentive adjustment that increased the investment management services fee by 0.04%) expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.70% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.60%, a performance incentive adjustment of 0.04%, and an administration fee of 0.06%), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.20% for Class A shares, 1.95% for Class B shares, 1.95% for Class C shares, 1.25% for Class T shares and 0.95% for Class Z shares.
(6) Other expenses have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual transfer agency fee rates, effective September 4, 2010.
(7) Columbia Management has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of the Buying Fund’s expenses so that Total annual Fund operating expenses (excluding any brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Buying Fund’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages of average daily net assets on an annualized basis: 1.11% for Class A shares, 1.86% for Class B shares, 1.86% for Class C shares, 1.16% for Class T shares and 0.86% for Class Z shares. The reimbursement arrangement shall continue in effect until November 30, 2012. These fee and expense arrangements may only be modified or amended with approval from all parties to such arrangements, including the Fund and Columbia Management.
(8) Management fees are composed of an investment management services fee of 0.69% and an administration fee of 0.06%. Management fees have been adjusted to reflect changes in contractual investment management fee rates (including the elimination of a performance incentive adjustment that increased the investment management services fee by 0.04%) expected to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval. If the proposed changes were not reflected, Management fees shown would have been 0.70% (composed of an investment management services fee of 0.60%, a performance incentive adjustment of 0.04%, and an administration fee of 0.06%), and Total annual Fund operating expenses would have been 1.13% for Class A shares, 1.86% for Class B shares, 1.86% for Class C shares, 1.17% for Class T shares and 0.88% for Class Z shares.

 

-20-


Table of Contents

 

Expense examples: These examples are intended to help you compare the cost of investing in each Fund with the cost of investing in other mutual funds. These examples assume that you invest $10,000 in the applicable Fund for the time periods indicated and then redeem all of your shares at the end of those periods, both under the current arrangements and, for the Buying Fund, assuming completion of the proposed Reorganization. These examples also assume that your investment has a 5% return each year and that each Fund’s operating expenses remain the same. The example includes any contractual fee waiver/expense reimbursement arrangement only for the period indicated in the Fund’s Annual Fund Operating Expenses table. Although your actual costs may be higher or lower, based on those assumptions your costs would be:

 

      1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 695       $ 949       $ 1,222       $ 1,999   

Class B

   $ 703       $ 927       $ 1,278       $ 2,134   

Class C

   $ 303       $ 627       $ 1,078       $ 2,327   

Class T

   $ 700       $ 963       $ 1,247       $ 2,053   

Class Z

   $ 102       $ 318       $ 552       $ 1,225   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 695       $ 949       $ 1,223       $ 2,004   

Class B

   $ 703       $ 928       $ 1,279       $ 2,138   

Class C

   $ 303       $ 628       $ 1,079       $ 2,332   

Class T

   $ 686       $ 964       $ 1,248       $ 2,097   

Class Z

   $ 102       $ 319       $ 553       $ 1,229   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class A

   $ 682       $ 922       $ 1,181       $ 1,923   

Class B

   $ 689       $ 900       $ 1,236       $ 2,058   

Class C

   $ 289       $ 600       $ 1,036       $ 2,253   

Class T

   $ 686       $ 937       $ 1,206       $ 1,977   

Class Z

   $ 88       $ 290       $ 509       $ 1,141   

If you owned or will own any class of shares other than Class B or Class C you would pay the same costs shown in the tables above if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated. If you owned or will own Class B or Class C shares, you would pay the following costs if you did not redeem your shares at the end of the periods indicated, which may be different than the costs shown in the tables above.

 

      1 year      3 years      5 years      10 years  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 203       $ 627       $ 1,078       $ 2,134   

Class C

   $ 203       $ 627       $ 1,078       $ 2,327   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 203       $ 628       $ 1,079       $ 2,138   

Class C

   $ 203       $ 628       $ 1,079       $ 2,332   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Pro Forma) (Buying Fund)

           

Class B

   $ 189       $ 600       $ 1,036       $ 2,058   

Class C

   $ 189       $ 600       $ 1,036       $ 2,253   

Portfolio Turnover. Each Fund pays transaction costs, such as commissions, when it buys and sells securities (or “turns over” its portfolio). A higher portfolio turnover rate may indicate higher transaction costs and may result in higher taxes when Fund shares are held in a taxable account. Those costs, which are not reflected in annual Fund operating expenses or in the example expenses, affect a Fund’s performance. During the most recent fiscal year, each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was the following percentage of the average value of the Fund’s portfolio:

 

-21-


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Percentage of the Average Value
of the Fund’s Portfolio

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Current) (Selling Fund)

   170%

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

   63%

 

-22-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 1. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

The Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

 

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

 

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights.

 

 

Are structured as a series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Massachusetts business trust and the Buying Fund is organized as a series of a Delaware statutory trust. Please see Exhibit C to this proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Selling Fund and shareholders of the Buying Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: Columbia Blended Equity Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Buying Fund: Columbia Large Cap Core Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that any Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund and the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

Both the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund invest in equity securities of U.S. and foreign companies. The Buying Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the S&P 500® Index, whereas the Selling Fund is not constrained by market capitalization. The Buying Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities, whereas the Selling Fund may invest in foreign securities without limit. The Buying Fund may, as principal investment strategies, invest in companies in the technology sector, exchange-traded funds, derivatives and special situations (such as initial public offerings); the Selling Fund has no similar principal investment strategies, though it may make the same investments.

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities. The Fund may invest in companies that have market capitalizations of any size.   Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Standard & Poor’s (S&P) 500® Index at the time of purchase [[(over $3.5 billion as of September, 2010)]].
The Fund invests in equity securities (including, but not limited to, common stocks, preferred stocks and securities convertible into common or preferred stocks).   The Fund normally invests in common stocks, preferred stocks and convertible securities like warrants and rights.
The Fund may invest in foreign securities, including securities of companies in emerging market countries. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.   The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities.

 

-23-


Table of Contents

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

  The Fund may invest in securities of companies in the technology sector and also may invest in exchange-traded funds.
The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.  
The Fund may invest in special situations such as companies involved in initial public offerings, tender offers, mergers and other corporate restructurings, and in companies involved in management changes or companies developing new technologies.  

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying investment opportunities and constructing the Buying Fund’s portfolio. Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

 

overall economic and market conditions.

 

 

the financial condition and management of a company, including its competitive position, the quality of its balance sheet and earnings, its future prospects, and the potential for growth and stock price appreciation.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target; if Columbia Management believes that there is deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

The Buying Fund’s investment strategy may involve the frequent trading of portfolio securities. This may cause the Buying Fund to incur higher transaction costs (which may adversely affect the Buying Fund’s performance) and may increase taxable distributions for shareholders.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. For purposes of this discussion, a “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

 

-24-


Table of Contents

 

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

Borrowing/ Issuing Senior Securities    The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.    The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.
Commodities    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may, to the extent consistent with its investment objective, invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, and purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions, including, without limitation, forward currency contracts.
Diversification    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.
Industry Concentration    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States, or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

 

-25-


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

Lending    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.
Real Estate    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate and may purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate.
Underwriting    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, except when it might technically be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with its investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered management investment companies.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    No stated policy, though applicable law prohibits the Fund from investing more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.

 

-26-


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

(Buying Fund)

Investments in Other Investment Companies    The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.
Short Selling    No stated policy.    The Fund may not sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

 

Investment Strategy Risk. Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. There is no assurance that the Buying Fund will achieve its investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Market Risk. Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Growth Securities Risk. Because growth securities typically trade at a higher multiple of earnings than other types of securities, the market values of growth securities may be more sensitive to changes in current or expected earnings than the market values of other types of securities. In addition, growth securities, at times, may not perform as well as value securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Value Securities Risk. Value securities are securities of companies that may have experienced, for example, adverse business, industry or other developments or may be subject to special risks that have caused the securities to be out of favor and, in turn, potentially undervalued. The market value of a portfolio security may not meet Columbia Management’s future value assessment of that security, or may decline. There is also a risk that it may take longer than expected for the value of these investments to rise to the believed value. In addition, value securities, at times, may not perform as well as growth securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Foreign Securities Risk. Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying

 

-27-


Table of Contents
 

Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Convertible Securities Risk. Convertible securities are subject to the usual risks associated with debt securities, such as interest rate risk and credit risk. Convertible securities also react to changes in the value of the common stock into which they convert, and are thus subject to market risk. Because the value of a convertible security can be influenced by both interest rates and market movements, a convertible security generally is not as sensitive to interest rates as a similar debt security, and generally will not vary in value in response to other factors to the same extent as the underlying common stock. In the event of a liquidation of the issuing company, holders of convertible securities would typically be paid before the company’s common stockholders but after holders of any senior debt obligations of the company. The Buying Fund may be forced to convert a convertible security before it otherwise would choose to do so, which may decrease the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to convertible securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investment, if any, in convertible securities.

 

 

Investing in Other Funds Risk. The performance of the funds, including exchange-traded funds, in which the Buying Fund invests could be adversely affected if other entities that invest in the same funds make relatively large investments or redemptions in the funds. In addition, because the expenses and costs of the funds are shared by investors in the underlying fund, redemptions by other investors in the underlying fund could result in decreased economies of scale and increased operating expenses for the underlying funds. These transactions might also result in higher brokerage, tax or other costs for the Buying Fund. This risk may be particularly important when one investor owns a substantial portion of any underlying fund. If an underlying fund pays fees to Columbia Management or its affiliates, this could result in Columbia Management having a potential conflict of interest in selecting the underlying funds in which the Buying Fund invests or in determining the percentage of the Buying Fund’s investments allocated to each underlying fund. There are also circumstances in which Columbia Management’s fiduciary duties to the Buying Fund may conflict with its fiduciary duties to the underlying funds for which it serves as investment manager. The Selling Fund is not subject to investing in other funds risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investment, if any, in other funds.

 

 

Technology Sector Risk. Securities of companies in the technology sector are subject to significant competitive pressures, such as aggressive pricing of their products or services, new market entrants, competition for market share, short product cycles due to an accelerated rate of technological developments and the potential for limited earnings and/or falling profit margins. These companies also face the risks that new services, equipment or technologies will not be accepted by consumers and businesses or will become rapidly obsolete. These factors can affect the profitability of technology companies and, as a result, the value of their securities. In addition, many technology companies have limited operating histories. Prices of these companies’ securities historically have been more volatile than other securities, especially over the short term. Because the Buying Fund invests a significant portion of its net assets in the equity securities of technology companies, the Buying Fund’s price may be more volatile than a fund that is invested in a more diverse range of market sectors. The Selling Fund is not subject to technology sector risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investment, if any, in companies in the technology sector.

 

 

Derivatives Risk. Derivatives are financial contracts whose values are, for example, based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or bond), assets (such as a commodity like gold or a foreign currency), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Derivatives involve special risks and may result in losses or may limit the Buying Fund’s potential gain from favorable market movements. Derivative strategies often involve leverage, which may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing the Buying Fund to lose more money than it would have lost had it invested in the underlying security or other asset. The values of derivatives may move in unexpected ways, especially in unusual market conditions, and may result in increased volatility, among other consequences. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount of taxes payable by shareholders holding shares in a taxable account. Other risks arise from the Buying Fund’s potential inability to terminate or to sell derivative positions. A liquid secondary market may not always exist for the Buying Fund’s derivative positions at times when the Buying Fund might wish to terminate or to sell such positions. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid, and transactions in derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. The use of derivatives also involves the risks of mispricing or improper valuation and that changes in the value of the derivative may not correlate perfectly with the underlying security, asset, reference rate or index. The Buying Fund also may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to engage in derivative transactions when it is deemed favorable to do so, or at all. For more information on the risks of derivative investments and strategies, see the Merger SAI. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-28-


Table of Contents

 

 

Frequent Trading Risk. Frequent trading of investments increases the possibility that the Buying Fund will realize taxable capital gains (including short-term capital gains, which are generally taxable at higher rates than long-term capital gains for U.S. federal income tax purposes), which could reduce the Buying Fund’s after-tax return. Frequent trading can also mean higher brokerage and other transaction costs, which could reduce the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to frequent trading risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its engagement, if any, in frequent trading.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

 

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

 

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

 

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

 

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) for Class C shares;

 

 

no sales charge for Class Z shares; and

 

 

except as noted for Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

 

-29-


Table of Contents

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-8.13%

   -16.10%    -20.58%    +26.55%    +10.08%    +3.66%    +16.94%    +10.47%    -37.62%    +22.57%

2000

   2001    2002    2003    2004    2005    2006    2007    2008    2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +15.42% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -23.03% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The returns shown for periods prior to March 31, 2008 include the returns of Blended Equity Fund, the predecessor to the Fund and a series of Excelsior Funds, Inc. The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to March 31, 2008 if they did.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +3.19%.

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-12.55%

   -12.42%    -27.67%    +27.30%    +8.07%    +5.90%    +15.42%    +9.97%    -35.89%    +24.00%

2000

   2001    2002    2003    2004    2005    2006    2007    2008    2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +14.67% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -20.25% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +1.49%.

Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)(1)

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +15.50     -0.71     -1.93

Return after taxes on distributions

     +15.37     -2.18     -2.89

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +10.22     -0.36     -1.58

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +20.70     +0.21     -1.48

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +22.94     +0.56     -1.30

S&P 500® Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +26.46     +0.42     -0.95

 

(1) The returns shown for periods prior to March 31, 2008 include the returns of Blended Equity Fund, the predecessor to the Fund and a series of Excelsior Funds, Inc. The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to March 31, 2008 if they did.

 

-30-


Table of Contents

 

Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +16.86     +0.15     -2.61

Return after taxes on distributions

     +16.67     -0.23     -2.83

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +11.18     +0.11     -2.19

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +22.15     +0.59     -2.79

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +24.38     +1.60     -1.83

S&P 500® Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +26.46     +0.42     -0.95

 

-31-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 2. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of each of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Comparison of each Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

All of the Selling Funds and the Buying Fund:

 

 

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights.

 

Are structured as a series of an open-end management investment company and are organized as series of a Massachusetts business trust. Please see Exhibit C to this proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Selling Fund and shareholders of the Buying Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: Columbia Select Opportunities Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Selling Fund: Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Buying Fund: Columbia Strategic Investor Fund seeks long-term growth of capital by using a “value” approach to invest primarily in common stocks.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of each of the Funds may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

Each Fund invests at least primarily in equity securities. The Buying Fund and Columbia Select Opportunities Fund may invest in securities of companies of any size, while Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund normally invests at least 80% of its securities in companies with market capitalizations in the range of the Russell Midcap Index. The Buying Fund has no 80% policy, while the 80% policy of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval upon sixty days’ notice. The Buying Fund may invest a significant amount of its assets in the securities of smaller companies. Each Fund may invest in foreign securities – up to 33% of total assets for the Buying Fund, up to 20% of total assets for Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund and without stated limit for Columbia Select Opportunities Fund. The Buying Fund and Columbia Select Opportunities Fund may invest in derivatives as a principal investment strategy; Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund has no similar principal investment strategy, though it may make the same investments. The Buying Fund may also invest in special situations (such as initial public offerings); Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund have no similar principal investment strategies, though they may make the same investments.

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

(the Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

(the Selling Fund)

    

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

(the Buying Fund)

Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities (including, but not limited to, common stocks, preferred stocks and securities convertible into common or preferred stocks). The Fund invests in equity securities, including common stocks, of companies that Columbia Management believes have value that is not reflected in their market prices. The Fund may invest in companies that have market capitalizations of any size.    Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities (including, but not limited to, common stocks, preferred stocks and securities convertible into common or preferred stocks) of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of the companies in the Russell Midcap Index at the time of purchase [[(between $1.26 billion and $14.13 billion as of May 31, 2010). ]]      Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests primarily in common stocks of companies that the Columbia Management believes are attractively valued and have the potential for long-term growth. The Fund may invest in companies that have market capitalizations of any size and may invest a significant amount of its assets in smaller companies.

 

-32-


Table of Contents

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

(the Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

(the Selling Fund)

    

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

(the Buying Fund)

The Fund may invest in foreign securities, including securities of companies in emerging market countries. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.    The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities.      The Fund may invest up to 33% of its total assets in foreign securities, including securities of companies in emerging market countries. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.
The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.         The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.
The Fund may invest in securities that the Adviser believes are undervalued, represent growth opportunities, or both.   

The Fund normally invests in common stocks, preferred stocks and convertible securities such as warrants and rights. The Fund also may invest in exchange-traded funds.

 

The Fund’s investment strategy may involve the frequent trading of portfolio securities.

    

The Fund may also invest in convertible securities, including preferred stock, warrants and debentures.

 

The Fund may invest in special situations such as initial public offerings, in companies involved in management changes, tender offers, mergers and other corporate restructurings and in companies developing new technologies.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental analysis with risk management in identifying investment opportunities and constructing the Fund’s portfolio. Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

 

businesses that are believed to be fundamentally sound and undervalued due to investor indifference, investor misperception of company prospects, or other factors.

 

 

various measures of valuation, including price-to-cash flow, price-to-earnings, price-to-sales, and price-to-book value.

 

 

a company’s current operating margins relative to its historic range and future potential.

 

 

potential indicators of stock price appreciation, such as anticipated earnings growth, company restructuring, changes in management, business model changes, new product opportunities or anticipated improvements in macroeconomic factors.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a target; if Columbia Management believes that there has been deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

Differences between each Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A

 

-33-


Table of Contents

comparison of the principal risks of investing in each Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganizations occur, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Each of the Funds have the same fundamental investment policies and therefore the Reorganizations will not result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. For purposes of this discussion, a “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

 

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Borrowing Money / Issuing Senior Securities   The Funds may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Commodities

  The Funds may not purchase or sell commodities, except that each Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.

Diversification

  The Funds may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.

Industry Concentration

  The Funds may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Lending

  The Funds may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Real Estate

  The Funds may not purchase or sell real estate, except each Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.

Underwriting

  The Funds may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “1933 Act”) except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.

Differences between each Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in each Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

 

-34-


Table of Contents

 

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganizations occur, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. There are no material differences between the non-fundamental investment policies of the Funds and therefore the Reorganizations will not result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Columbia Select Opportunities
Fund

  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

  

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Illiquid Securities

   No stated policy, though applicable law prohibits the fund from investing more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.
Investment in Other Investment Companies    No Fund may purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of one of these Funds are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.

Differences between each Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in each Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Funds are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Funds are also described below.

 

   

Investment Strategy Risk – Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Buying Fund’s investment objective. There is no assurance that the Buying Fund will achieve its investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Buying Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Buying Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. Each Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Market Risk – Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Buying Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Buying Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Buying Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Buying Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. Each Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Value Securities Risk – Value securities are securities of companies that may have experienced, for example, adverse business, industry or other developments or may be subject to special risks that have caused the securities to be out of favor and, in turn, potentially undervalued. The market value of a portfolio security may not meet Columbia Management’s future value assessment of that security, or may decline. There is also a risk that it may take longer than expected for the value of these investments to rise to the believed value. In addition, value securities, at times, may not perform as well as growth securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. Columbia Select Opportunities Fund is also subject to this principal risk. Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund is not subject to value securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in value securities.

 

   

Growth Securities Risk – Because growth securities typically trade at a higher multiple of earnings than other types of securities, the prices of growth securities may be more sensitive to changes in current or expected earnings than the prices of other types of securities. In addition, growth securities, at times, may not perform as well as value securities or the stock

 

-35-


Table of Contents
 

market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. Columbia Select Opportunities Fund is also subject to this principal risk. Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund is not subject to growth securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in growth securities.

 

   

Smaller Company Securities Risk – Securities of small- or mid-capitalization companies (“smaller companies”) can, in certain circumstances, have a higher potential for gains than securities of large-capitalization companies but may also have more risk. For example, smaller companies may be more vulnerable to market downturns and adverse business or economic events than larger, more established companies because they may have more limited financial resources and business operations. These companies are also more likely than larger companies to have more limited product lines and operating histories and to depend on smaller management teams. Their securities may trade less frequently and in smaller volumes and may be less liquid and fluctuate more sharply in value than securities of larger companies. In addition, some smaller companies may not be widely followed by the investment community, which can lower the demand for their stocks. Each Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Foreign Securities Risk – Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Buying Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Buying Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. Each Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Emerging Market Securities Risk – Securities issued by foreign governments or companies in emerging market countries, like those in Eastern Europe, the Middle East, Asia, Latin America or Africa are more likely to have greater exposure to the risks of investing in foreign securities that are described in Foreign Securities Risk. In addition, emerging market countries are more likely to experience instability resulting, for example, from rapid social, political and economic development. Their economies are usually less mature and their securities markets are typically less developed with more limited trading activity than more developed countries. Emerging market securities tend to be more volatile than securities in more developed markets. Many emerging market countries are heavily dependent on international trade, which makes them more sensitive to world commodity prices and economic downturns in other countries. Some emerging market countries have a higher risk of currency devaluations, and some of these countries may experience periods of high inflation or rapid changes in inflation rates. Each Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Derivatives Risk – Derivatives are financial contracts whose values are, for example, based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or bond), assets (such as a commodity like gold or a foreign currency), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Derivatives involve special risks and may result in losses or may limit the Buying Fund’s potential gain from favorable market movements. Derivative strategies often involve leverage, which may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing the Buying Fund to lose more money than it would have lost had it invested in the underlying security. The values of derivatives may move in unexpected ways, especially in unusual market conditions, and may result in increased volatility, among other consequences. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount of taxes payable by shareholders. Other risks arise from the Buying Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell derivative positions. A liquid secondary market may not always exist for the Buying Fund’s derivative positions at times when the Buying Fund might wish to terminate or sell such positions. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid, and transactions in derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. The use of derivatives also involves the risks of mispricing or improper valuation and that changes in the value of the derivative may not correlate perfectly with the underlying security, asset, reference rate or index. The Buying Fund also may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to engage in derivative transactions when it is deemed favorable to do so, or at all. For more information on the risks of derivative investments and strategies, see the Buying Fund’s Statement of Additional Information. Each Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

-36-


Table of Contents

 

   

Convertible Securities Risk – Convertible securities are subject to the usual risks associated with debt securities, such as interest rate risk and credit risk. Convertible securities also react to changes in the value of the common stock into which they convert, and are thus subject to market risk. Because the value of a convertible security can be influenced by both interest rates and market movements, a convertible security generally is not as sensitive to interest rates as a similar debt security, and generally will not vary in value in response to other factors to the same extent as the underlying common stock. In the event of a liquidation of the issuing company, holders of convertible securities would typically be paid before the company’s common stockholders but after holders of any senior debt obligations of the company. The Buying Fund may be forced to convert a convertible security before it otherwise would choose to do so, which may decrease the Buying Fund’s return. The Selling Funds are not subject to convertible securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of their investments, if any, in convertible securities.

 

   

Currency Risk – Securities denominated in different currencies are subject to the risk that, for example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the U.S. dollar value of any securities held by the Buying Fund denominated in that currency. The Selling Funds are not subject to currency risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of their investments, if any, in securities denominated in non-U.S. currencies.

 

   

Special Situations Risk – Securities of companies that are involved in an initial public offering or a major corporate event, such as a business consolidation or restructuring, may present special risk because of the high degree of uncertainty that can be associated with such events. Securities issued in initial public offerings often are issued by companies that are in the early stages of development, have a history of little or no revenues and may operate at a loss following the offering. It is possible that there will be no active trading market for the securities after the offering, and that the market price of the securities may be subject to significant and unpredictable fluctuations. Investing in special situations may have a magnified effect on the performance of funds with small amounts of assets The Selling Funds are not subject to special situations risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of their investments, if any, in special situations.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A and Class Z share information, as applicable, is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. The inception date for Class R shares of the Buying Fund was September 27, 2010; accordingly, performance information for that class is not shown. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum applicable sales charge for Class A shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) for Class C shares;

 

   

no sales charge for Class Z shares; and

 

   

except as noted for Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

Indices are not available for investment, and do not reflect sales charges, fees, brokerage commissions, taxes or other expenses of investing.

 

-37-


Table of Contents

 

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS Z SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+6.81%

   +19.41%      +16.09%      -43.82%      +34.36%  

2005

     2006         2007         2008         2009   

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +18.82% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -27.34% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The returns shown for periods prior to March 31, 2008 include the returns of Equity Opportunities Fund, the predecessor to the Fund and a series of Excelsior Funds Trust (the Predecessor Fund). The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to September 28, 2007 if they did. The Predecessor Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2004.

The Fund’s Class Z shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was 4.66%.

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS Z SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+4.22%

   +8.43%      -15.75%      +44.64%      +15.18%      +4.64%      +19.45%      +1.80%      -49.78%      +33.15%  

2000

     2001         2002         2003         2004         2005         2006         2007         2008         2009   

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +21.06% (quarter ended June 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -27.69% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The returns shown for periods prior to March 31, 2008 include the returns of Mid Cap Value and Restructuring Fund, the predecessor to the Fund and a series of Excelsior Funds Trust (the Predecessor Fund). The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to March 31, 2008 if they did.

The Fund’s Class Z shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was 10.49%.

 

-38-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS Z SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+29.76%

   -8.56%      +36.45%      +15.70%      +7.38%      +14.58%      +14.77%      -41.51%      +37.14%  

2001

     2002         2003         2004         2005         2006         2007         2008         2009   

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +19.81% (quarter ended June 30, 2003) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -25.00% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class Z year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +4.23%.

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5  years(1)     Life of Fund
(March 31,
2004)(1)
 

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

(Selling Fund):

      

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +34.36     +2.25     +3.52

Return after taxes on distributions

     +34.19     +2.03     +3.32

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +22.49     +1.95     +3.05

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +26.41     +0.98     +2.40

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +32.00     +1.80     +3.12

S&P 500® Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +26.46     +0.42     +1.88

Russell 1000 Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +28.43     +0.79     +2.26

 

(1) The returns shown for periods prior to March 31, 2008 include the returns of Equity Opportunities Fund, the predecessor to the Fund and a series of Excelsior Funds Trust (the Predecessor Fund). The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to September 28, 2007 if they did. The Predecessor Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2004.

 

-39-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5  years(1)     10  years(1)  

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

(Selling Fund):

      

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +33.15     -3.18     +3.04

Return after taxes on distributions

     +32.91     -3.34     +1.71

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +21.78     -2.63     +2.04

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +25.08     -4.41     +2.38

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +31.03     -3.47     +2.89

Class R

      

Return before taxes

     +32.30     -3.67     +2.78

Russell Midcap Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +40.48     +2.43     +4.98

Russell Midcap Value Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses, or taxes)

     +34.21     +1.98     +7.58

 

(1) The returns shown for periods prior to March 31, 2008 include the returns of Mid Cap Value and Restructuring Fund, the predecessor to the Fund and a series of Excelsior Funds Trust (the Predecessor Fund). The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to March 31, 2008 if they did.

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     Life of Fund
(November 9,
2000)(1)
 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund):

      

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +37.14     +2.53     +9.96

Return after taxes on distributions

     +37.01     +1.46     +9.22

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +24.31     +2.15     +8.80

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +28.79     +1.05     +9.03

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +30.64     +1.20     +9.08

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +34.73     +1.50     +9.09

Russell 1000 Index (reflects no deduction for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +28.43     +0.79     -0.33

 

(1) Class A shares were initially offered on November 1, 2002, and Class Z shares were initially offered on November 9, 2000. Class A and Class B are newer classes of shares. Their performance information includes returns of the Fund’s Class Z shares (the oldest existing Fund class) for periods prior to their inception. The returns for Class C shares include the returns for Class B shares for periods prior to October 13, 2003, the date on which Class C shares were initially offered by the Fund. The returns shown for Class C shares also include the returns of Class Z shares for periods prior to November 1, 2002, the date on which Class B shares were initially offered by the Fund. These returns reflect differences in sales charges, but have not been restated to reflect any differences in expenses between Class Z (or Class B) shares and the newer classes of shares. If differences in expenses had been reflected, the returns shown would be lower.

 

-40-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 3. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

   

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

   

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights.

 

   

Are structured as a series of an open-end management investment company. Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II is organized as a series of a Delaware statutory trust while Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I is organized as a series of a Massachusetts business trust. Please see Exhibit C to this proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Selling Fund and the shareholders of the Buying Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II seeks long-term growth of capital.

Buying Fund: Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I seeks capital appreciation by investing, under normal market conditions, at least 80% of its net assets (plus any borrowings for investment purposes) in stocks of companies with a market capitalization, at the time of initial purchase, equal to or less than the largest stock in the Standard & Poor’s (S&P) SmallCap 600 Index.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. The investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed without shareholder approval, while the investment objective of the Buying Fund may be changed only with shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

The Selling Fund normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell 2000 Growth Index at the time of purchase, while the Buying Fund normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the S&P SmallCap 600 Index at the time of purchase. The Buying Fund may invest in derivatives as a principal investment strategy; the Selling Fund has no similar principal investment strategy, though it may make such investments.

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II
(the Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

(the Buying Fund)

Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell 2000 Growth Index at the time of purchase.

 

The Fund’s 80% policy may be changed by the Fund’s Board on 60 days’ notice to shareholders.

  

Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the S&P SmallCap 600 Index at the time of purchase.

 

The Fund’s 80% policy may be changed by the Fund’s Board on 60 days’ notice to shareholders.

The Fund normally invests in common stocks.    The Fund invests primarily in common stocks of companies that Columbia Management believes have the potential for long-term, above-average earnings growth.
The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities.    The Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities. The Fund may invest directly in foreign securities or indirectly through depositary receipts. Depositary receipts are receipts issued by a bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by foreign companies.
The Fund may invest in securities of companies in the technology sector. The Fund also may from time to time emphasize one or more economic sectors in selecting its investments.   

 

-41-


Table of Contents

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II
(the Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

(the Buying Fund)

   The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset. The Fund may also invest in convertible securities, including preferred stock, warrants and debentures.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

Columbia Management combines fundamental and quantitative analysis with risk management in identifying investment opportunities and constructing the Buying Fund’s portfolio. In doing this, Columbia Management considers, among other factors:

 

   

overall economic and market conditions.

 

   

the financial condition and management of a company, including its competitive position, the quality of its balance sheet and earnings, its future prospects, and the potential for growth and stock price appreciation.

Columbia Management may sell a security when the security’s price reaches a set target; if Columbia Management believes that there is deterioration in the issuer’s financial circumstances or fundamental prospects, or that other investments are more attractive; or for other reasons.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. For purposes of this discussion, a “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

Borrowing

Money/Issuing

Senior Securities

   The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.    The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Commodities    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may, to the extent consistent with its investment objective, invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, and purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions, including, without limitation, forward currency contracts.    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.

 

-42-


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

Diversification    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.
Industry Concentration    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States, or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States, or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Lending    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.
Real Estate    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate and may purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate.    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.

 

-43-


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

Underwriting    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might technically be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with its investment objective. This restriction does not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered management investment companies.    The Fund may not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction does not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.
Securities of other Investment Companies    The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.
Short Selling    The Fund may not sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.    No stated policy.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

 

Investment Strategy Risk—Columbia Management uses the principal investment strategies and other investment strategies to seek to achieve the Fund’s investment objective. Investment decisions made by Columbia Management in using these strategies

 

-44-


Table of Contents
 

may not produce the returns expected by Columbia Management, may cause the Fund’s shares to lose value or may cause the Fund to underperform other funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Market Risk—Market risk refers to the possibility that the market values of securities that the Fund holds will rise or fall, sometimes rapidly or unpredictably. Security values may fall because of factors affecting individual companies, industries or sectors, or the markets as a whole, reducing the value of an investment in the Fund. Accordingly, an investment in the Fund could lose money over short or even long periods. The market values of the securities the Fund holds also can be affected by changes or perceived changes in U.S. or foreign economies and financial markets, and the liquidity of these securities, among other factors. In general, equity securities tend to have greater price volatility than debt securities. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Growth Securities Risk—Because growth securities typically trade at a higher multiple of earnings than other types of securities, the prices of growth securities may be more sensitive to changes in current or expected earnings than the prices of other types of securities. In addition, growth securities, at times, may not perform as well as value securities or the stock market in general, and may be out of favor with investors for varying periods of time. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Smaller Company Securities Risk—Securities of small- or mid-capitalization companies (“smaller companies”) can, in certain circumstances, have a higher potential for gains than securities of large-capitalization companies but may also have more risk. For example, smaller companies may be more vulnerable to market downturns and adverse business or economic events than larger, more established companies because they may have more limited financial resources and business operations. These companies are also more likely than larger companies to have more limited product lines and operating histories and to depend on smaller management teams. Their securities may trade less frequently and in smaller volumes and may be less liquid and fluctuate more sharply in value than securities of larger companies. In addition, some smaller companies may not be widely followed by the investment community, which can lower the demand for their stocks. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Foreign Securities Risk—Foreign securities are subject to special risks as compared to securities of U.S. issuers. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies, or in U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that the Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable times or prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees are also generally higher for foreign securities. The Fund may have limited or no legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain foreign securities, including those issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which could reduce the amount of income and capital gains available to distribute to shareholders. Other risks include possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the payment of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; the impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards that may be less comprehensive and stringent than those applicable to domestic companies. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Derivatives Risk—Derivatives are financial contracts whose values are, for example, based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or bond), assets (such as a commodity like gold or a foreign currency), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Derivatives involve special risks and may result in losses or may limit the Fund’s potential gain from favorable market movements. Derivative strategies often involve leverage, which may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing the Fund to lose more money than it would have lost had it invested in the underlying security. The values of derivatives may move in unexpected ways, especially in unusual market conditions, and may result in increased volatility, among other consequences. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount of taxes payable by shareholders. Other risks arise from the Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell derivative positions. A liquid secondary market may not always exist for the Fund’s derivative positions at times when the Fund might wish to terminate or sell such positions. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid, and transactions in derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. The use of derivatives also involves the risks of mispricing or improper valuation and that changes in the value of the derivative may not correlate perfectly with the underlying security, asset, reference rate or index. The Fund also may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to engage in derivative transactions when it is deemed favorable to do so, or at all. The Selling Fund is not subject to derivatives risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in derivatives.

 

 

Convertible Securities Risk—Convertible securities are subject to the usual risks associated with debt securities, such as interest rate risk and credit risk. Convertible securities also react to changes in the value of the common stock into which they convert, and are thus subject to market risk. Because the value of a convertible security can be influenced by both interest rates and market movements, a convertible security generally is not as sensitive to interest rates as a similar debt security, and generally will not

 

-45-


Table of Contents
 

vary in value in response to other factors to the same extent as the underlying common stock. In the event of a liquidation of the issuing company, holders of convertible securities would typically be paid before the company’s common stockholders but after holders of any senior debt obligations of the company. The Fund may be forced to convert a convertible security before it otherwise would choose to do so, which may decrease the Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to convertible securities risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent of its investments, if any, in convertible securities.

 

 

Currency Risk—Securities denominated in different currencies are subject to the risk that, for example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the U.S. dollar value of any securities held by the Fund denominated in that currency. The Selling Fund is not subject to currency risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent it holds investments, if at all, in non-U.S. currencies.

 

 

Industry Sector Risk—At times, the Fund may have a significant portion of its assets invested in securities of companies conducting business in the same industry or in a closely related group of industries within an economic sector. Companies in the same industry or sector may be similarly affected by economic or market events, making the Fund more vulnerable to unfavorable developments in an industry or sector than funds that invest more broadly. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

 

Frequent Trading Risk—Frequent trading of investments increases the possibility that the Fund will realize taxable capital gains (including short-term capital gains, which are generally taxable at higher rates than long-term capital gains for federal income tax purposes), which could reduce the Fund’s after-tax return. Frequent trading can also mean higher brokerage and other transaction costs, which could reduce the Fund’s return. The Selling Fund is not subject to frequent trading risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent it engages, if at all, in frequent trading of investments.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waivers or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A and Class Z share information, as applicable, is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. These returns are compared to the recognized measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum sales charge for Class A shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) for Class B and Class C shares;

 

   

No sales charge for Z shares; and

 

   

except as noted for Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

 

-46-


Table of Contents

 

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-1.83%

   -12.22%      -27.97%      +37.12%      +9.94%      +6.41%      +12.11%      +12.68%      -40.99%      +25.14%  

2000

     2001         2002         2003         2004         2005         2006         2007         2008         2009   

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +20.76% (quarter ended December 31, 2001) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -28.53% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +8.61%.

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

CLASS Z SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

+5.85%

   -14.19%      -26.58%      +44.29%      +9.61%      +13.14%      +16.72%      +21.49%      -42.79%      +37.68%  

2000

     2001         2002         2003         2004         2005         2006         2007         2008         2009   

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +22.93% (quarter ended March 31, 2000) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -28.52% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions of sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class Z shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +12.17%.

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended Dec. 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years  
Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund):       

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +17.97     -1.32     -1.32

Return after taxes on distributions

     +17.97     -3.30     -2.55

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +11.68     -1.28     -1.24

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +19.30     -1.12     -1.48

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +23.32     +0.89     -1.48

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +25.40     +0.10     -0.49

Russell 2000 Growth Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +34.47     +0.87     -1.37

 

-47-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund):

      

Class Z(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +37.68     +4.80     +2.92

Return after taxes on distributions

     +37.68     +3.63     +1.99

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +24.49     +3.96     +2.21

Class A(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +29.46     +3.35     +2.21

Class B(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +31.28     +3.64     +2.50

Class C(1)

      

Return before taxes

     +35.23     +3.94     +2.50

Russell 2000 Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +21.17     +0.51     +3.51

Russell 2000 Growth Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +34.47     +0.87     -1.37

 

(1) Class A, Class B and Class C are newer classes of shares. Their performance information includes returns of the Fund’s Class Z shares (the oldest existing Fund class) for periods prior to their inception. These returns reflect differences in sales charges but have not been restated to reflect any differences in expenses, such as distribution and service (Rule 12b-1) fees between Class Z shares and the newer classes of shares. If differences in expenses had been reflected, the returns shown for periods prior to the inception of the newer classes of shares would have been lower, since the newer classes of shares are subject to distribution and service (Rule 12b-1) fees. Class A, Class B and Class C shares were initially offered on November 1, 2005, and Class Z shares were initially offered on October 1, 1996.

 

-48-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 4. Comparison of Objectives, Strategies and Risks. Reorganization of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

Comparison of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund

Both the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund:

 

 

Have Columbia Management as investment manager.

 

 

Have the same policies for buying and selling shares and the same exchange rights.

 

 

Are structured as a series of an open-end management investment company. The Selling Fund is organized as a series of a Massachusetts business trust and the Buying Fund is organized as series of a Minnesota corporation. The Board of Directors of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. has approved the Redomiciling of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, a series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., into a newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust that has also been named Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. The Redomiciling is subject to approval by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. If the Redomiciling is approved by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, it is expected that the Redomiciling will occur prior to the Reorganization, in which case the Buying Fund will be the newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust. If the Redomiciling has not been completed prior to the closing of the Reorganization, the Buying Fund will be the existing series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. Please see Exhibit C to this proxy statement/prospectus for more information regarding the differences between the rights of shareholders of the Selling Fund and the shareholders of the Buying Fund.

Comparison of Investment Objectives

The investment objectives of the Funds are as follows:

Selling Fund: Columbia Disciplined Value Fund seeks total return, consisting primarily of long-term capital appreciation, and secondarily of current income.

Buying Fund: Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital growth.

Because any investment involves risk, there can be no assurance that a Fund’s investment objective will be achieved. Only shareholders can change the investment objective of the Buying Fund, while the investment objective of the Selling Fund may be changed without shareholder approval.

Comparison of Principal Investment Strategies

The Buying Fund normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies with market capitalizations that are (i) over $5 billion at the time of purchase or (ii) within the capitalization range of companies in the Russell 1000® Value Index (the “Index”) at the time of purchase, while the Selling Fund may invest in companies that have market capitalizations of any size, but invests most of its assets in companies that have market capitalizations of more than $1.5 billion. The Selling Fund attempts to maintain a portfolio that matches the risk characteristics of the Index, while the Buying Fund is not similarly constrained.

Additional information regarding the principal investment strategies of each Fund is set forth below:

 

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

(Buying Fund)

Under normal circumstances, the Fund invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities that Columbia Management believes are undervalued. The Fund may invest in companies that have market capitalizations of any size, but invests most of its assets in companies that have market capitalizations of more than $1.5 billion. The Fund will typically hold a selection of common stocks included in the Index.    Under normal market conditions, at least 80% of the Fund’s net assets will be invested in equity securities of companies with market capitalizations of over $5 billion at the time of purchase or that are within the capitalization range of companies in the Index at the time of purchase.
Columbia Management attempts to maintain a portfolio that generally matches the risk characteristics of the Index. Columbia   

 

-49-


Table of Contents

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

(Buying Fund)

Management will vary the number and percentages of the Fund’s holdings in attempting to provide higher returns than the Index and to reduce the potential of underperforming the Index over time. The Fund generally holds fewer stocks than the Index and may hold securities that are not in the Index.   
The Fund may invest in derivatives, including futures, forwards, options, swap contracts and other derivative instruments. The Fund may invest in derivatives for both hedging and non-hedging and non-hedging purposes, including, for example, to seek to enhance returns or as a substitute for a position in an underlying asset.    Columbia Management may use derivatives such as futures, options, swaps and forward contracts to produce incremental earnings, to hedge existing positions, to maintain investment efficiency or to increase flexibility.
   The Fund can invest in any economic sector and, at times, it may emphasize one or more particular sectors.

Buying Fund Investment Style

A description of the investment style of the Buying Fund is set forth below:

In pursuit of the Buying Fund’s objective, Columbia Management seeks to identify companies that appear to be undervalued by various measures or that may be temporarily out of favor, but which are believed to have good prospects for capital appreciation. Columbia Management will choose equity investments by employing proprietary, disciplined quantitative methods.

Columbia Management’s disciplined quantitative approach is designed to identify companies with:

 

   

Attractive valuations, based on factors such as price-to-earnings ratios;

 

   

Sound balance sheets; or

 

   

Improving outlooks, based on an analysis of return patterns over time.

The universe of stocks from which Columbia Management selects the Buying Fund’s investments primarily will be those included in the Index.

In selecting the stocks for the Buying Fund’s portfolio, Columbia Management employs a rigorous process for evaluating the relationship between the risk associated with each security and its potential for positive returns. This process includes factors such as:

 

   

Limits on positions relative to weightings in the benchmark index.

 

   

Limits on sector and industry allocations relative to the benchmark index.

 

   

Limits on size of holdings relative to market liquidity.

In evaluating whether to sell a security, Columbia Management considers, among other factors, whether:

 

   

The security is overvalued relative to other potential investments.

 

   

The company does not meet Columbia Management’s performance expectations.

Columbia Management may use derivatives such as futures, options, swaps and forward contracts, to produce incremental earnings, to hedge existing positions, maintain investment efficiency or to increase flexibility.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

 

-50-


Table of Contents

 

Comparison of Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the fundamental investment policies of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the fundamental investment policies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund result in any material difference in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed. For purposes of this discussion, a “fundamental” investment policy is one that may not be changed without a shareholder vote.

The Funds’ fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

Policy

  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

(Buying Fund)

Borrowing/Issuing Senior Securities    The Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.   

The Fund will not borrow money, except for temporary purposes (not for leveraging or investment) in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings) immediately after the borrowings.

 

The Fund will not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

Commodities    The Fund may not purchase or sell commodities, except that each Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs. (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.    The Fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from buying or selling options, futures contracts and foreign currency or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.
Diversification    The Fund may not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (ii) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, and any applicable exemptive relief.    The Fund will not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (a) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (b) the Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.
Industry Concentration    The Fund may not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provide that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any    The Fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the Securities and Exchange Commission, this means that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.

 

-51-


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

(Buying Fund)

   state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities, or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulation thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.   
Lending    The Fund may not make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.    The Fund will not lend securities or participate in an interfund lending program if the total of all such loans would exceed 33 1/3% of the fund’s total assets except this fundamental investment policy shall not prohibit the fund from purchasing money market securities, loans, loan participation or other debt securities, or from entering into repurchase agreements.
Real Estate    The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interest in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interest in real estate acquired through exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein.    The Fund will not buy or sell real estate, unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from investing in securities or other instruments backed by real estate or securities of companies engaged in the real estate business or real estate investment trusts. For purposes of this policy, real estate includes real estate limited partnerships.
Underwriting    The Fund will not underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933 except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies.    The Fund will not act as an underwriter (sell securities for others). However, under the securities laws, the fund may be deemed to be an underwriter when it purchases securities directly from the issuer and later resells them.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” beginning on page [].

Comparison of Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

If the Reorganization occurs, the combined Fund will be subject to the non-fundamental investment policies (policies that may be changed without a shareholder vote) of the Buying Fund. Columbia Management does not believe that the differences between the non-fundamental policies of the Funds result in any material differences in the way the Funds have been managed or in the way the combined Fund will be managed.

The Funds’ non-fundamental investment policies are set forth below:

 

-52-


Table of Contents

 

Policy

  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

(Selling Fund)

  

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

(Buying Fund)

Illiquid Securities    The Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid securities.    No more than 15% of the Fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.
Investing for Purposes of Exercising Control    The Fund will not purchase securities of companies for the purpose of exercising control.    No stated policy.
Limiting Investments in Foreign Securities    No stated policy.    Up to 25% of the Fund’s net assets may be invested in foreign investments.
Securities of Open-End Investment Companies    The Fund may not purchase securities of other investment companies except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of the Fund are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.    No stated policy.
Short Sales    The Fund may not sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.    No stated policy.

Differences between the Selling Fund’s principal investment strategies, fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies and holdings and those of the Buying Fund may expose the Selling Fund’s shareholders to new or increased risks. A comparison of the principal risks of investing in the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund is provided under “Comparison of Principal Risks” below.

Comparison of Principal Risks

Although the Funds describe them somewhat differently, the principal risks associated with investments in the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund are generally similar because the Funds have similar investment objectives, principal investment strategies and investment policies. The actual risks of investing in each Fund depend on the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio and on market conditions, both of which change over time. The Buying Fund is subject to the principal risks described below. Similarities and material differences between the Buying Fund’s principal risks and those of the Selling Fund are also described below.

 

   

Active Management Risk. The Fund is actively managed and its performance therefore will reflect in part the ability of the portfolio managers to select securities and to make investment decisions that are suited to achieving the Fund’s investment objective. Due to its active management, the Fund could underperform other mutual funds with similar investment objectives. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Derivatives Risk. Derivatives are financial instruments that have a value which depends upon, or is derived from, the value of something else, such as one or more underlying securities, pools of securities, options, futures, indexes or currencies. Losses involving derivative instruments may be substantial, because a relatively small price movement in the underlying security(ies), instrument, currency or index may result in a substantial loss for the Fund. In addition to the potential for increased losses, the use of derivative instruments may lead to increased volatility within the Fund. Derivative instruments in which the Fund invests will typically increase the Fund’s exposure to principal risks to which it is otherwise exposed, and may expose the Fund to additional risks, including counterparty credit risk, hedging risk, correlation risk, liquidity risk and leverage risk.

Counterparty credit risk is the risk that a counterparty to the derivative instrument becomes bankrupt or otherwise fails to perform its obligations due to financial difficulties, and the Fund may obtain no recovery of its investment or may only obtain a limited recovery, and any recovery may be delayed.

 

-53-


Table of Contents

 

Hedging risk is the risk that derivative instruments used to hedge against an opposite position may offset losses, but they may also offset gains. There is no guarantee that a hedging strategy will eliminate the risk which the hedging strategy is intended to offset, which may lead to losses within the Fund.

Correlation risk is related to hedging risk and is the risk that there may be an incomplete correlation between the hedge and the opposite position, which may result in increased or unanticipated losses.

Liquidity risk is the risk that the derivative instrument may be difficult or impossible to sell or terminate, which may cause the Fund to be in a position to do something Columbia Management would not otherwise choose, including accepting a lower price for the derivative instrument, selling other investments or foregoing another, more appealing investment opportunity. Derivative instruments which are not traded on an exchange, including, but not limited to, forward contracts, swaps and over-the-counter options, may have increased liquidity risk.

Leverage risk is the risk that losses from the derivative instrument may be greater than the amount invested in the derivative instrument.

Certain derivatives have the potential for unlimited losses, regardless of the size of the initial investment. See the Buying Fund’s SAI for more information on derivative instruments and related risks.

The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Issuer Risk. An issuer may perform poorly, and therefore, the value of its stocks and bonds may decline. Poor performance may be caused by poor management decisions, competitive pressures, breakthroughs in technology, reliance on suppliers, labor problems or shortages, corporate restructurings, fraudulent disclosures or other factors. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Market Risk. The market value of securities may fall or fail to rise. Market risk may affect a single issuer, sector of the economy, industry, or the market as a whole. The market value of securities may fluctuate, sometimes rapidly and unpredictably. In addition, focus on a particular style, for example, investment in growth or value securities, may cause the Fund to underperform other mutual funds if that style falls out of favor with the market. The Selling Fund is also subject to this principal risk.

 

   

Sector Risk. If a fund emphasizes one or more economic sectors, it may be more susceptible to the financial, market or economic events affecting the particular issuers and industries in which it invests than funds that do not emphasize particular sectors. The more a fund diversifies across sectors, the more it spreads risk and potentially reduces the risks of loss and volatility. The Selling Fund is not subject to sector risk as a principal risk, but may be subject to such risk to the extent it emphasizes one or more sectors.

 

   

Quantitative Model Risk. Securities selected using quantitative methods may perform differently from the market as a whole for many reasons, including the factors used in building the quantitative analytical framework, the weights placed on each factor, and changing sources of market returns, among others. There can be no assurance that these methodologies will enable the Fund to achieve its objective. The Selling Fund is not subject to this principal risk.

Performance

The following bar charts and tables provide some illustration of the risks of investing in the Funds by showing, respectively:

 

   

how each Fund’s performance has varied for each full calendar year shown in the bar chart; and

 

   

how each Fund’s average annual total returns compare to certain measures of market performance shown in the table.

Both the bar chart and the table assume that all distributions have been reinvested. The performance of different classes varies because of differences in sales charges and other fees and expenses. How a Fund has performed in the past (before and after taxes) does not indicate how the Fund will perform in the future. The performance shown reflects any fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements in effect for the periods reported. In the absence of such fee waiver or expense reimbursement arrangements, the performance shown would have been lower.

Bar Charts. Class A share information is shown in the bar charts; the sales charge for Class A shares is not reflected in the bar charts.

 

-54-


Table of Contents

 

Tables. The tables below show total returns from hypothetical investments in the indicated classes of shares of each Fund. Class T shares and Class Z shares of the Buying Fund are new; therefore, no performance information is shown for such shares. The returns shown are compared to measures of market performance shown for the same periods. The performance calculations in the tables assume:

 

   

the maximum sales charge for Class A and Class T shares;

 

   

sales at the end of the indicated period and deduction of the applicable contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) for Class B and Class C shares;

 

   

no sales charge for Class Z shares; and

 

   

except as noted for Class A shares, no adjustments for taxes paid by an investor on reinvested income and capital gains.

After-Tax Returns

After-tax returns are shown only for Class A shares. After-tax returns for the other share classes will vary. After-tax returns are calculated using the highest historical individual U.S. federal marginal income tax rate and do not reflect the effect of foreign, state or local taxes. Actual after-tax returns will depend on your tax situation and most likely will differ from the returns shown in the table. If you hold your shares in a tax-deferred account, such as a 401(k) plan or an IRA, the after-tax returns do not apply to you because you will not incur taxes until you begin to withdraw from your account.

The return after taxes on distributions for a period may be the same as the return before taxes for the same period if there were no distributions or if the distributions were small. The return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares for a period may be greater than the return before taxes for the same period if there was a tax loss realized on the sale of Fund shares. The benefit of the tax loss (because it can be used to offset other gains) may result in a higher return.

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

-3.19%   +4.79%     -29.72%     +28.23%     +13.42%     +10.15%     +22.59%     +1.05%     -38.67%     +20.65%  
2000     2001        2002        2003        2004        2005        2006        2007        2008        2009   

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was +18.65% (quarter ended September 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -21.50% (quarter ended December 31, 2008).

These returns do not reflect deductions for sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +4.60%.

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

CLASS A SHARE PERFORMANCE

(based on calendar years)

 

    + 20.26%    
2009

During the periods shown in the bar chart, the highest return for a calendar quarter was + 18.96% (quarter ended Sept. 30, 2009) and the lowest return for a calendar quarter was -16.74% (quarter ended March 31, 2009).

These returns do not reflect deductions for sales charges, if any, paid by investors and would be lower if they did. The performance of other share classes may vary from that shown because of differences in expenses.

The Fund’s Class A shares year-to-date return at September 30, 2010 was +6.64%.

 

-55-


Table of Contents

 

The Fund’s shares became available to the public on August 1, 2008.

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     5 years     10 years  

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)(1)

      

Class A

      

Return before taxes

     +13.72     -0.99     -0.13

Return after taxes on distributions

     +13.43     -2.25     -1.40

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +9.20     -0.88     -0.44

Class B

      

Return before taxes

     +14.79     -0.80     -0.30

Class C

      

Return before taxes

     +18.71     -0.54     -0.32

Class T

      

Return before taxes

     +13.78     -1.02     -0.18

Class Z

      

Return before taxes

     +21.00     +0.47     +0.76

Russell 1000 Value Index (reflects no deductions for fees, expenses or taxes)

     +19.69     -0.25     +2.47

 

(1) The returns shown for periods prior to November 25, 2002 include the returns of Galaxy Equity Value Fund, the predecessor to the Fund. The returns shown do not reflect any differences in expenses between the share classes and would be lower for periods prior to November 25, 2002 if they did.

 

-56-


Table of Contents

 

Average Annual Total Returns (for periods ended December 31, 2009)

 

     1 year     Since inception
(August  1, 2008)
 

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

    

Class A

    

Return before taxes

     +13.34     -18.22

Return after taxes on distributions

     +11.60     -19.27

Return after taxes on distributions and sale of Fund shares

     +8.73     -15.97

Class B

    

Return before taxes

     +14.23     -17.66

Class C

    

Return before taxes

     +18.30     -15.39

Russell 1000 Value Index
(reflects reinvestment of all distributions and changes in market prices)

     +19.69     -8.62

Lipper Large-Cap Value Funds Index (include net reinvested Dividends)

     +24.96     -5.94

 

-57-


Table of Contents

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ABOUT EACH REORGANIZATION

Terms of the Reorganizations

The Board of each Fund has approved the Agreement. While shareholders are encouraged to review the Agreement, which has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this combined proxy statement/prospectus is a part, the following is a summary of certain terms of the Agreement:

 

 

Each Reorganization is expected to occur before the end of the second quarter of 2011, pending shareholder approval, receipt of any necessary regulatory approvals and satisfaction of any other conditions to closing. However, following shareholder approval, each Reorganization may happen at any time agreed to by the applicable Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund.

 

 

Each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund and, in exchange, the corresponding Buying Fund will assume all the Selling Fund’s liabilities and will issue Reorganization Shares to the Selling Fund. The value of each Selling Fund’s assets, as well as the number of Reorganization Shares to be issued to the Selling Fund, will be determined in accordance with the Agreement. The Reorganization Shares will have an aggregate net asset value on the business day immediately preceding the closing of the Reorganization equal to the value of the assets received from the Selling Fund, less the liabilities assumed by the corresponding Buying Fund in the transaction. The Reorganization Shares will immediately be distributed to Selling Fund shareholders in proportion to their holdings of shares of the Selling Fund, in liquidation of the Selling Fund. As a result, shareholders of the Selling Fund will become shareholders of the corresponding Buying Fund. No shareholders of any Selling Fund will pay any sales charge in connection with its Reorganization.

 

 

The net asset value of each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund will be computed as of the close of regular trading on the New York Stock Exchange on the business day next preceding the closing date of the applicable Reorganization.

The Board of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. has approved the Redomiciling of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, a series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., into a newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust that has also been named Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. The Redomiciling is subject to approval by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. If the Redomiciling is approved by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, it is expected that the Redomiciling will occur prior to the Reorganizations, in which case the Buying Fund will be the newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust. If the Redomiciling has not been completed prior to the closing of the Reorganization, the Buying Fund will be the existing series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. which, if the Redomiciling is approved, may thereafter be redomiciled.

Conditions to Closing Each Reorganization

The completion of each Reorganization is subject to certain conditions described in the Agreement, including:

 

 

The Selling Fund will have declared and paid a dividend that, together with all previous dividends, will distribute all of the Selling Fund’s net investment income and net capital gains, if any, to the shareholders of the Selling Fund for its tax years ending on or prior to the closing date of the Reorganization.

 

 

The Funds will have received any approvals, consents or exemptions from the SEC or any other regulatory body necessary to carry out the Reorganization.

 

 

A registration statement on Form N-14 relating to the Reorganization will have been filed with the SEC and become effective.

 

 

The shareholders of the Selling Fund will have approved the Agreement by the requisite vote.

 

 

The Selling Fund will have received an opinion of tax counsel to the effect that, as described in more detail in the section entitled “Tax Status of the Reorganizations,” the shareholders of the Selling Fund will not recognize gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the exchange of their Selling Fund shares for the Reorganization Shares of the corresponding Buying Fund in connection with the Reorganization.

 

-58-


Table of Contents

 

Termination of the Agreement

The Agreement and the transactions contemplated by it may be terminated and abandoned with respect to any Reorganization by resolution of the Board of any applicable Fund at any time prior to the closing date thereof. In the event of a termination, Columbia Management will bear all costs associated with the Reorganization.

Tax Status of the Reorganizations

Each Reorganization is intended to qualify for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a tax-free reorganization under section 368(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). As a condition to the closing of each Reorganization, each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund will receive an opinion from Ropes & Gray LLP to the effect that, as further described below, on the basis of existing provisions of the Code, U.S. Treasury regulations issued thereunder, current administrative rules, pronouncements and court decisions, for U.S. federal income tax purposes:

 

 

The Reorganization will constitute a “reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(a)(1) of the Code, and the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund will each be “a party to a reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(b) of the Code.

 

 

Under Sections 361 and 357 of the Code, no gain or loss will be recognized by the Selling Fund upon the transfer of all of its assets to the Buying Fund in exchange for Reorganization Shares and the assumption by Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund, or upon the distribution of the Reorganization Shares by the Selling Fund to its shareholders in liquidation.

 

 

Under Section 354 of the Code, no gain or loss will be recognized by the shareholders of the Selling Fund upon the exchange of their Selling Fund shares for Reorganization Shares of the Buying Fund.

 

 

Under Section 358 of the Code, the aggregate tax basis of Reorganization Shares that a Selling Fund shareholder receives in the Reorganization will be the same as the aggregate tax basis of the Selling Fund shares exchanged therefor.

 

 

Under Section 1223(1) of the Code, a Selling Fund shareholder’s holding period for the Reorganization Shares received in the Reorganization will be determined by including the shareholder’s holding period for the Selling Fund shares exchanged therefor, provided the shareholder held such Selling Fund shares as capital assets.

 

 

Under Section 1032 of the Code, no gain or loss will be recognized by the Buying Fund upon the receipt of assets of the Selling Fund in exchange for Reorganization Shares and the assumption by the Buying Fund of all of the liabilities of the Selling Fund.

 

 

Under Section 362(b) of the Code, the Buying Fund’s tax basis in the assets of the Selling Fund transferred to the Buying Fund in the Reorganization will be the same as the Selling Fund’s tax basis in such assets immediately prior to the Reorganization.

 

 

Under Section 1223(2) of the Code, the Buying Fund’s holding periods in the assets received from the Selling Fund in the Reorganization will include the Selling Fund’s holding periods in such assets.

 

 

The Buying Fund will succeed to and take into account the items of the Selling Fund described in Section 381(c) of the Code, subject to the conditions and limitations specified in Sections 381, 382, 383 and 384 of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

Ropes & Gray LLP will express no view with respect to the effect of a Reorganization on any transferred asset as to which any unrealized gain or loss is required to be recognized under U.S. federal income tax principles (i) at the end of a taxable year or upon the termination thereof, or (ii) upon the transfer of such asset regardless of whether such a transfer would otherwise be a non-taxable transaction.

Each opinion will be based on certain factual certifications made by the officers of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund and will also be based on customary assumptions. Each opinion will note and distinguish certain published precedent. It is possible that the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) or a court could disagree with Ropes & Gray LLP’s opinion, which opinion therefore cannot be free from doubt.

Opinions of counsel are not binding upon the IRS or the courts. If a Reorganization were consummated but did not qualify as a tax-free reorganization under the Code, a shareholder of the Selling Fund would recognize a taxable gain or loss equal to the difference between his or her tax basis in his or her Selling Fund shares and the fair market value of the Reorganization Shares of the Buying

 

-59-


Table of Contents

Fund he or she received. Shareholders of a Selling Fund should consult their tax advisors regarding the effect, if any, of the Reorganization in light of their individual circumstances.

Portfolio manager substitutions in connection with the closing of the acquisition by Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management, of the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC and certain of its affiliated companies from Bank of America, N.A., and independent of the Reorganizations, have occurred and have resulted in turnover of a portion, including a substantial portion, of the portfolio assets of certain Funds. An additional portion, including a substantial portion, of the portfolio assets of each Buying Fund or Selling Fund may also be sold at any time before or after the Reorganization in connection with its Reorganization. The actual tax effect of such sales depends on the difference between the price at which such portfolio assets are sold and the tax basis in such assets of the Fund making the sale. Any capital gains recognized in these sales on a net basis, after reduction by any available capital losses, will be distributed to shareholders as capital gain dividends (to the extent of net realized long-term capital gains over net realized short-term capital losses) and/or ordinary dividends (to the extent of net realized short-term capital gains over net realized long-term capital losses) during or with respect to the year of sale, and such distributions will be taxable to shareholders. Each Reorganization will end the tax year of the applicable Selling Fund, and will therefore accelerate any distributions to shareholders from the Selling Fund for its short tax year ending on the date of the Reorganization. Those tax year-end distributions will be taxable and will include any undistributed capital gains resulting from portfolio turnover prior to the Reorganization.

More generally, prior to the closing of each Reorganization, the Selling Fund will, and the Buying Fund may, declare a distribution to shareholders, which, together with all previous distributions, will have the effect of distributing to shareholders all of its investment company taxable income (computed without regard to the deduction for dividends paid), net tax-exempt income, if any, and net realized capital gains, if any, through the closing of the Reorganization, including any undistributed income or gains from prior years. These distributions will be taxable to shareholders, and such distributions by a Selling Fund will include any distributable, but undistributed, capital gains resulting from portfolio turnover prior to the Reorganization. If a shareholder holds shares of either Fund in a non-taxable account, distributions with respect to those shares will not be taxable to the shareholder if the amount distributed remains in the nontaxable account.

A Fund’s ability to carry forward capital losses and to use them to offset future gains may be limited as a result of the Reorganization. First, a Fund’s “pre-acquisition losses” (including capital loss carryforwards, net current-year capital losses, and unrealized losses that exceed certain thresholds) may become unavailable to offset gains of the combined Fund to the extent such pre-acquisition losses exceed an annual limitation amount. Second, one Fund’s pre-acquisition losses cannot be used to offset gains in another Fund that are “built in” (unrealized) at the time of the Reorganizations and that exceed certain thresholds (“non-de minimis built-in gains”) for five tax years. Third, a Selling Fund’s loss carryforwards, as limited under the previous two rules, are permitted to offset only that portion of the gains of the Buying Fund for the taxable year of the Reorganization that is equal to the portion of the Buying Fund’s taxable year that follows the date of the Reorganization (prorated according to number of days). Therefore, in certain circumstances, shareholders of a Fund may pay taxes sooner, or pay more taxes, than they would have had the Reorganizations not occurred.

In addition, the combined Fund will have tax attributes that reflect a blending of the tax attributes of each Fund at the time of the Reorganizations (including as affected by the rules described above). Therefore, the shareholders of the Selling Fund will in each case receive a proportionate share of any “built-in” (unrealized) gains in the combined Fund’s assets, as well as any taxable income or gains realized by the Buying Fund but not distributed to its shareholders prior to the Reorganization, when such income or gains are eventually distributed by the Buying Fund. As a result, shareholders of a Selling Fund may receive a greater amount of taxable distributions than they would have had the Reorganizations not occurred. In addition, any pre-acquisition losses of the Selling Fund (whether realized or unrealized) remaining after the operation of the limitation rules described above will become available to offset capital gains realized by the combined Fund after the Reorganizations and thus may reduce subsequent capital gain distributions to a broader group of shareholders than would have been the case absent such Reorganizations, such that the benefit of those losses to Selling Fund shareholders may be further reduced relative to what the benefit would have been had the Reorganizations not occurred.

The effect of the rules described above will depend on the relative sizes of, and the losses and gains (both realized and unrealized) in, each Fund at the time of the Reorganizations and thus cannot be calculated precisely prior to the Reorganizations.

The realized and unrealized gains and losses of each Fund at the time of its Reorganization, and the occurrence of other Reorganizations involving the same Buying Fund, will determine the extent to which the combining Funds’ respective losses, both realized and unrealized, will be available to reduce gains realized by the combined Fund following the Reorganization, and consequently the extent to which the combined Fund may be required to distribute gains to its shareholders earlier or in greater amounts than would have been the case absent the Reorganization. The following paragraphs provide a brief summary of the tax

 

-60-


Table of Contents

effect of each of the Reorganizations assuming all Reorganizations occurred on February 28, 2010. As noted above, the tax effect of a Reorganization depends on each Fund’s relative tax situation at the time of the Reorganization, which situation will be different than the tax situation on February 28, 2010 and cannot be calculated precisely prior to the Reorganization. Portfolio turnover in a Fund, market fluctuations, redemption activity or the nonoccurrence of one or more other Reorganizations into the same Buying Fund could cause the actual tax effect of the Reorganizations to differ substantially from that described below. For purposes of the following discussion, a Fund’s “net realized losses” consist of its capital loss carryforwards plus year-to-date net realized losses or net of year-to-date net realized gains, in each case as of February 28, 2010.

Proposal 1. Reorganization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund.

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had no carryforward losses, net realized gains equal to about 3.3% of net assets and unrealized net gains equal to about 44.6% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized losses of approximately 20.7% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses expiring in eight years, and net unrealized gains equal to about 10.1% of net assets.

If the Reorganization occurred on February 28, 2010, Selling Fund would have technically been subject to an annual loss limitation, but the limitation would have had no effect because Selling Fund had no pre-merger net losses. The Reorganization would have permitted the Selling Fund to spread its proportionately larger net unrealized gains, if and when realized after the Reorganization, across the larger combined Fund, resulting in a potential tax benefit to Selling Fund shareholders and a potential tax cost to Buying Fund shareholders.

Proposal 2. Reorganizations of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

As of February 28, 2010, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 94.1% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses expiring in eight years, and net unrealized gains equal to about 22.1% of net assets. Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund had net realized losses equal to about 4.0% of net assets, consisting entirely of carryforward losses expiring in eight years, and net unrealized gains equal to about 16.5% of net assets. Columbia Strategic Investor Fund had net realized losses equal to approximately 23.5% of net assets, consisting primarily of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses expiring in eight years, and net unrealized gains equal to about 17.4% of net assets.

If the Reorganizations occurred on February 28, 2010, each Selling Fund would have become subject to annual loss limitations, but the limitation would have had no practical effect on Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund because its pre-Reorganization losses were smaller than the limitation. The loss limitation rules would have limited the combined Fund’s ability to use the net realized losses of the Columbia Select Opportunities Fund to offset gains recognized by the combined Fund. The limitation potentially could have resulted in earlier and larger taxable distributions, and therefore a greater tax cost to Columbia Select Opportunities Fund shareholders, than if the Reorganizations had not occurred. Further, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund’s proportionately larger net unrealized gains, if and when realized after the Reorganization, would have been spread across the larger combined Fund, thereby increasing the potential tax cost to Columbia Select Opportunities Fund shareholders and resulting in a potential tax benefit to Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund shareholders. Columbia Strategic Investor Fund’s losses would not have been subject to an annual limitation; the sharing of those losses across the larger combined Fund could have resulted in a potential tax cost to shareholders of Columbia Strategic Investor Fund.

Proposal 3. Reorganization of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had net realized losses of approximately 39.3% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses expiring in eight years, and unrealized net gains equal to about 8.8% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized losses equal to about 9.8% of net assets, consisting of year-to-date losses and carryforward losses expiring in eight years, and net unrealized gains totaling about 17.1% of net assets.

If the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, Selling Fund would have become subject to an annual loss limitation. The loss limitation rules would have limited the combined Fund’s ability to use the net realized losses of Selling Fund to offset gains recognized by the combined Fund. The limitation potentially could have resulted in earlier and larger taxable distributions, and therefore a greater tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders, than if the Reorganization had not occurred. The Reorganization would have permitted the Buying Fund to spread its proportionately larger net unrealized gains, if and when realized after the Reorganization,

 

-61-


Table of Contents

across the larger combined Fund, resulting in a potential tax benefit to Buying Fund shareholders and an additional potential tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders.

Proposal 4. Reorganization of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

As of February 28, 2010, the Selling Fund had net realized losses of approximately 50.4% of net assets, consisting of carryforward losses expiring in seven and eight years, and unrealized net gains equal to about 14.6% of net assets. The Buying Fund had net realized gains equal to about 5.2% of net assets and net unrealized gains equal to about 16.6% of net assets.

If the Reorganization had occurred on February 28, 2010, Buying Fund would have technically been subject to an annual loss limitation, but the limitation would have had no effect because Buying Fund had no pre-merger net losses. The Reorganization would have permitted the Buying Fund to spread its proportionately larger net realized and (if and when realized after the Reorganization) net unrealized gains across the larger combined Fund, and would have caused the Selling Fund to spread its proportionately larger net realized losses across the larger combined Fund, resulting in each case in a potential tax benefit to Buying Fund shareholders and a corresponding potential tax cost to Selling Fund shareholders.

 

 

The tax principles described above will apply in each case and are not expected to change prior to the Reorganizations. However, the results of their application and, at a minimum, the specific percentages noted above will change prior to each Reorganization because of market developments and volatility in the marketplace, any pre-Reorganization realignments or other sales of portfolio securities that already have occurred or that might occur and shareholder activity in the Funds, among other changes.

This description of the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganizations is made without regard to the particular facts and circumstances of any shareholder. Shareholders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the effect, if any, of the Reorganization in light of their individual circumstances. Because the foregoing discussion relates only to the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganizations, shareholders of a Selling Fund should also consult their tax advisors as to the state, local and foreign tax consequences, if any, of the Reorganizations.

Reasons for the Proposed Reorganizations and Board Deliberations

Each Reorganization was reviewed by the Board of the Selling Fund involved therein, with the advice and assistance of Fund counsel and independent legal counsel to such Board. Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund and Columbia Disciplined Value Fund are overseen by one Board (the “Columbia Atlantic Board”); Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II is overseen by a second Board (the “Columbia Nations Board”). At regular and special meetings of each Selling Fund’s Board in May, June and August 2010, each Board considered the Reorganization of each Selling Fund overseen by it, as proposed by Columbia Management. In connection with those Board meetings, Columbia Management and its affiliates provided background materials, analyses and other information to each Board regarding, among other things, the topics discussed below, including responses to specific requests by each Board, and responded to questions raised by each Board at those meetings. The Board also considered information provided in connection with various other proposals by Columbia Management to integrate the funds advised by Columbia Management into a single fund family with greater uniformity, including proposals to standardize fees charged by Columbia Management and its affiliates, as well as other service providers, for services provided to similar funds.

After each Board reviewed, evaluated and discussed the materials, analyses and information provided to it that the Board considered relevant to its deliberations, each Board, including the independent Board members thereof, unanimously approved the Reorganization of each Selling Fund overseen by it. Each Board, including the independent Board members thereof, also unanimously determined that participation by each Selling Fund overseen by it in its Reorganization was in the best interests of the Selling Fund and that the interests of existing shareholders of the Selling Fund would not be diluted as a result of the Reorganization.

The general factors considered by each Board in assessing and approving each applicable Reorganization included, among others, in no order of priority:

 

  1. various potential benefits of the Reorganization to the shareholders of the Selling Fund;

 

  2. the Reorganization as part of Columbia Management’s overall commitment to streamline and to improve its fund offerings for the benefit of Fund shareholders;

 

-62-


Table of Contents

 

  3. the investment objectives and principal investment strategies of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund;

 

  4. the operating expenses that shareholders of each class of shares of the Selling Fund are expected to experience as shareholders of the Buying Fund after the Reorganization relative to the operating expenses currently borne by such shareholders, including that, on a net basis, such expenses generally are expected to decline (for Columbia Select Opportunities Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, to increase slightly) as a result of the Reorganization and including Columbia Management’s contractual agreement to limit the total operating expenses of the Buying Fund (see “Fees and Expenses”);

 

  5. the current assets of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund, and the anticipated combined pro forma assets of the Buying Fund after the Reorganization;

 

  6. the portfolio management team expected to be responsible for the combined Fund, and the historical performance of the Selling Fund and the Buying Fund, recognizing that no assurances can be given that the Buying Fund will achieve any particular level of performance after the Reorganization;

 

  7. the likelihood that the Selling Fund would achieve and/or maintain sufficient size to ensure its continued economic viability absent the Reorganization, and the Buying Fund’s relative prospects for attracting additional assets after the Reorganization;

 

  8. the anticipated tax-free nature of the exchange of shares in the Reorganization, and other expected U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Reorganization, including potential limitations on the Buying Fund’s use of the Funds’ pre-merger losses for U.S. federal income tax purposes after the Reorganization and the potential diminution of the Buying Fund’s ability to use those losses to offset future gains (see “Tax Status of the Reorganizations”);

 

  9. the potential benefits of the Reorganization to Columbia Management and its affiliates;

 

  10. that shareholders of the Selling Fund will experience no material change in shareholder services as a result of the Reorganization;

 

  11. any brokerage costs resulting from the Reorganization (e.g., the Selling Fund’s turnover associated with and resulting from the sale of any securities the Buying Fund cannot, or does not wish to, acquire); and

 

  12. that the direct costs associated with the Reorganization will be borne by the Selling Fund only to the extent that Columbia Management anticipates a reduction in expenses to shareholders of the Selling Fund in the first year following the Reorganization.

 

  13. With respect to Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund only, Columbia Management has agreed to monitor any brokerage commissions attributable to the merger (as distinct from ordinary course transactions) and to bear such commissions to the extent they exceed the estimated brokerage costs that would be associated with the liquidation of such Selling Fund’s portfolio.

In their deliberations, the Boards did not identify any single factor that was paramount or controlling and individual Board members may have attributed different weights to various factors. Each Board also evaluated the information available to it on a Selling Fund-by-Selling Fund basis, and made determinations separately in respect of each Selling Fund it oversees. Certain of the factors considered by each Board are discussed in more detail below.

STREAMLINED PRODUCT LINE. Each Board considered that the Reorganizations are intended, among other things, to streamline Columbia Management’s product offerings by reducing the number of funds in the Combined Fund Complex. Reducing the number of funds in the complex is intended to enhance the funds’ prospects for attracting additional assets by better differentiating the funds for potential shareholders (which should lead to a more concentrated selling effort).

CONTINUITY OF INVESTMENT. Each Board took into account the fact that each applicable Selling Fund and its corresponding Buying Fund have similar investment objectives and principal investment strategies. Specifically, the relevant Board noted the following with respect to each Reorganization:

Proposal 1

Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund. The Columbia Atlantic Board noted that both Columbia Blended Equity Fund and the Buying Fund seek long-term capital appreciation. The Columbia Atlantic Board also noted that each of Columbia Blended Equity Fund and the Buying Fund normally invest in equity securities of U.S. and foreign companies. The Columbia Atlantic Board further noted that the Buying Fund normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the S&P 500® Index, while Columbia Blended Equity Fund is not constrained by market capitalization. The Columbia Atlantic Board considered that the Buying Fund may invest up to 20% of its total assets in foreign securities, whereas Columbia Blended Equity Fund may invest in foreign securities without limit.

 

-63-


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 2

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund. The Columbia Atlantic Board noted that Columbia Select Opportunities Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation, while the Buying Fund seeks long-term growth of capital by using a “value” approach to invest primarily in common stocks. The Columbia Atlantic Board considered that each Fund may invest in securities of companies of any size. The Columbia Atlantic Board also noted that Columbia Select Opportunities Fund may invest in foreign securities to a greater extent than may the Buying Fund.

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund. The Columbia Atlantic Board noted that Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund seeks long-term capital appreciation, while the Buying Fund seeks long-term growth of capital by using a “value” approach to invest primarily in common stocks. The Columbia Atlantic Board also noted that the Buying Fund may invest in foreign securities to a greater extent than may Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund and that although Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in the equity securities of companies with market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell Midcap Index, the Buying Fund is not similarly constrained with respect to market capitalization.

Proposal 3

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I. The Columbia Nations Board noted that Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II seeks long-term growth of capital, while the Buying Fund seeks capital appreciation by investing, under normal market conditions, at least 80% of its net assets (plus any borrowings for investment purposes) in stocks of companies with a market capitalization, at the time of initial purchase, equal to or less than the largest stock in the Standard & Poor’s (S&P) SmallCap 600 Index. The Columbia Nations Board further noted that Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities of companies that have market capitalizations in the range of companies in the Russell 2000 Growth Index at the time of purchase.

Proposal 4

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. The Columbia Atlantic Board noted that Columbia Disciplined Value Fund seeks total return, consisting primarily of long-term capital appreciation, and secondarily of current income as an investment objective, while the Buying Fund seeks to provide shareholders with long-term capital growth. The Columbia Atlantic Board further noted that the Buying Fund normally invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities of companies with market capitalizations that are (i) over $5 billion at the time of purchase or (ii) within the capitalization range of companies in the Russell 1000® Value Index at the time of purchase, while Columbia Disciplined Value Fund may invest in companies that have market capitalizations of any size, but invests most of its assets in companies that have market capitalizations of more than $1.5 billion. The Columbia Atlantic Board considered that the Selling Fund attempts to maintain a portfolio that matches the risk characteristics of the Russell 1000® Value Index, while the Buying Fund is not similarly constrained.

[[EXPENSE RATIO. Each Board took into account the fact that the total operating expense ratio of each applicable Selling Fund is generally expected to decrease following its Reorganization. For Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, the Columbia Atlantic Board considered that, based on estimated operating expense ratios, shareholders of each class of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund are expected to bear total operating expenses (after taking into account any applicable expense caps) after the Reorganization that are slightly higher than the current total operating expenses of that Fund.]]

INVESTMENT PERFORMANCE. Each Board considered the relative performance record of each Selling Fund overseen by it and of each corresponding Buying Fund, noting, however, that past performance is no guarantee of future results. Specifically, the relevant Board noted the following with respect to each Reorganization:

Proposal 1

Columbia Blended Equity Fund into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund. The Columbia Atlantic Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which Columbia Blended Equity Fund’s performance was better for the one- and ten-year periods, but the Buying Fund’s performance was better for the three- and five-year periods, and that each Fund received identical risk-adjusted performance ratings for all applicable periods from an independent information provider.

Proposal 2

 

-64-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

The Columbia Atlantic Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which the Buying Fund’s performance was better for all applicable periods, and that each Fund received identical risk-adjusted performance ratings for the three-year period, but the Buying Fund received higher ratings for the five-year period from an independent information provider.

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

The Columbia Atlantic Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund’s performance was better for the one- and five-year periods, but the Buying Fund’s performance was better for the three- and ten-year periods, and that the Buying Fund received higher risk-adjusted performance ratings for all applicable periods from an independent information provider.

Proposal 3

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

The Columbia Nations Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which the Buying Fund’s performance was better for all applicable periods, and that the Buying Fund received higher risk-adjusted performance ratings for the three- and five-year periods and each Fund received identical ratings for the ten-year period from an independent information provider.

Proposal 4

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

The Columbia Atlantic Board considered the relative performance of the Funds for periods ending February 28, 2010, during which Columbia Disciplined Value Fund’s performance was better for the ten-year/life of Fund period, but the Buying Fund’s performance was better for the one-year period. The Columbia Atlantic Board also considered Columbia Disciplined Value Fund’s risk-adjusted performance ratings for the three-, five- and ten-year periods from an independent information provider.

ECONOMIES OF SCALE. Each Board observed that, in addition to the potential to realize immediate economies associated with consolidating a smaller Selling Fund into a larger combined Fund, such as the elimination of duplicative costs, the combined funds may be able to take advantage of other economies of scale associated with larger funds. For example, a larger fund may benefit from fee breakpoints more quickly, may have an enhanced ability to effect portfolio transactions on favorable terms and may have greater investment flexibility. Each Board also considered the potential benefits and economies of scale to Columbia Management resulting from the Reorganizations and whether those benefits were shared with Fund shareholders. Each Board also considered Columbia Management’s belief that each Buying Fund would be better positioned to experience growth in assets from investor inflows than each Selling Fund overseen by such Board.

Board Recommendation and Required Vote

The Board of each Selling Fund recommends that shareholders of the Selling Fund approve the proposed Agreement. For each Selling Fund, the Agreement must be approved by the affirmative vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Selling Fund, as defined in the 1940 Act. A vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Selling Fund is defined in the 1940 Act as the affirmative vote of the lesser of (a) 67% or more of the voting securities of the Selling Fund that are present or represented by proxy at the Meeting, if the holders of more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities of the Selling Fund are present or represented by proxy at the Meeting; or (b) more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities of the Selling Fund.

If the Agreement is not approved for a Selling Fund, the applicable Board will consider what further action should be taken with respect to the Selling Fund. The approval of the Reorganization of one Selling Fund is not conditioned upon the approval of the Reorganization of any other Selling Fund.

If shareholders approve the Reorganization of a Selling Fund, it is anticipated that the Reorganization would occur before the end of the second quarter of 2011.

 

-65-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION B – BOARD PROPOSALS

Proposal 5 – Election of Trustees

(Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II)

On May 1, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II’s investment manager, acquired the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC and certain of its affiliated companies from Bank of America, N.A. (the “Transaction”). In connection with the Transaction, Columbia Management became the investment manager of the Columbia-branded funds (the “Columbia Fund ongoing Complex”), in addition to the funds then branded as RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds (the “Columbia RiverSource Fund Complex,” and together with the Columbia Fund Complex, the “Combined Fund Complex”).

Following the Transaction, the boards of directors/trustees of the RiverSource Fund Complex (collectively, the “Columbia RiverSource Board”) and of the Columbia Fund Complex had ongoing discussions regarding a potential consolidated board of directors/trustees to oversee all or a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. In September 2010, these discussions culminated in an agreement between the Columbia RiverSource Board and the current Nations Board to have a consolidated board of directors/trustees for a portion of the Combined Fund Complex. Specifically, it was agreed that the RiverSource Fund Complex and the portion of the Columbia Fund Complex overseen by the Columbia Nations Board should be overseen by a consolidated board of directors/trustees. In this regard, the Columbia Nations Board and Columbia RiverSource Board each determined that the consolidation would enhance the oversight of a larger fund family should achieve cost efficiencies for fund shareholders.

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (the “Board Election Fund”) is a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust (“CFST”). In order to effect the consolidation, at a meeting held on September 20, 2010, the Governance Committee of the Columbia Nations Board nominated and recommended the nomination of the Non-Interested Nominees (defined below) to the Columbia Nations Board. In addition, at a meeting held on September 20, 2010, the Columbia Nations Board, including a majority of the trustees who are not “interested persons,” as defined in the 1940 Act, of CFST (the “Non-Interested Trustees”), unanimously accepted and endorsed those nominations, nominated the Interested Nominees (defined below), and voted to present each of the Non-Interested Nominees and the Interested Nominees (the “Nominees”) to shareholders for election as trustees. The Columbia Nations Board currently has no reason to believe that any Nominee will become unavailable for election as a trustee, but if unavailability should occur before the Meeting, the proxies will be voted for such other individuals as the Governance Committee of the Columbia Nations Board and the full Columbia Nations Board may designate.

A Nominee is deemed to be “non-interested” to the extent the Nominee is not an “interested person,” as that term is defined in Section 2(a)(19) of the 1940 Act, of CFST (the “Non-Interested Nominees”). The Non-Interested Nominees are: Kathleen Blatz; Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.; Pamela G. Carlton; William P. Carmichael; Patricia M. Flynn; William A. Hawkins; R. Glenn Hilliard; Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.; John F. Maher; John J. Nagorniak; Catherine James Paglia; Leroy C. Richie; Alison Taunton-Rigby; and Minor M. Shaw.

Anthony M. Santomero and William F. Truscott (the “Interested Nominees”) are or would be treated as “interested persons” of CFST. Although Mr. Santomero is “independent” of Columbia Management and its affiliates, in that he is not a director, officer or employee thereof, CFST treats Mr. Anthony M. Santomero as an “interested person” of the trust (or “Interested Trustee”) because he serves as a director of Citigroup, Inc. and Citigroup, N.A. Citigroup, Inc., which may engage from time to time in brokerage execution, principal transactions and/or lending relationships with funds that are a series of CFST or other funds or accounts advised/managed by Columbia Management and/or a CFST fund’s subadviser. William F. Truscott is an “interested person” of CFST because he serves as Chairman of the Board of Columbia Management (and was previously the President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management from 2001-2010) and as a senior executive of Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management, in which he is also a stockholder.

If the Nominees are elected by shareholders, at least 75% of the Columbia Nations Board’s trustees will continue to be Non-Interested Trustees. The Nominees would serve as trustees in accordance with the organizational documents of CFST. Each trustee would serve for an indefinite term. A trustee’s term may terminate by the election of his or her successor, by the termination or dissolution of CFST, or by his or her death, resignation, removal, retirement or incapacity. A trustee may no longer serve on the Columbia Nations Board after the first board meeting after he or she reaches the mandatory retirement age established by the Columbia Nations Board or after the fifteenth anniversary of the first Columbia Nations Board meeting he or she attended as a trustee.

 

-66-


Table of Contents

 

Information Regarding the Non-Interested Nominees

Background information regarding each of the Non-Interested Nominees follows.

 

Name, Address and Age

 

Position(s) Held or
to be Held with the
Board Election Fund

 

Term of Office and Length
of Time Served as a Trustee

 

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(1)
  Other Directorships
Held by Nominee

During the Past
Five Years

Kathleen Blatz

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age [56]

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  Chief Justice, Minnesota Supreme Court, 1998-2006; Attorney   193   None

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [66]

  Trustee   Indefinite term; Trustee since January 2005   Managing Director – E.J. Boudreau & Associates (consulting), from 2000 through current   193   BofA Funds Series
Trust (11 funds)

Pamela G. Carlton

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 56

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  President, Springboard-Partners in Cross Cultural Leadership (consulting company)   193   None

William P. Carmichael

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [67]

  Trustee and Chairman of the Board   Indefinite term; Trustee since 1999   Retired   193   BofA Funds Series
Trust (11 funds);
Cobra Electronics
Corporation (electronic
equipment
manufacturer);
Simmons Company
(bedding); The Finish
Line (sportswear)

Patricia M. Flynn

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 59

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  Trustee Professor of Economics and Management, Bentley University; former Dean, McCallum Graduate School of Business, Bentley University   193   None

William A. Hawkins

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [68]

  Trustee   Indefinite term; Trustee since January 2005   President and Chief Executive Officer – California Bank, N.A., from January 2008 through current   193   BofA Funds Series
Trust (11 funds)

R. Glenn Hilliard

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [67]

  Trustee   Indefinite term; Trustee since January 2005   Chairman and Chief Executive Officer – Hilliard Group LLC (investing and consulting), from April 2003 through current; Non-Executive Director & Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), September 2003 through current; Executive Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), August 2004 through September 2005   193   BofA Funds Series
Trust (11 funds);
Conseco, Inc.
(insurance)

 

-67-


Table of Contents

Name, Address and Age

 

Position(s) Held or

to be Held with the
Board Election Fund

 

Term of Office and Length
of Time Served as a Trustee

 

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(1)
 

Other Directorships
Held by Nominee During
the Past Five Years

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 71

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  President Emeritus and Professor of Economics, Carleton College   [193]   Valmont Industries, Inc. (manufactures irrigation systems)

John F. Maher

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 67

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  Retired President and Chief Executive Officer and former Director, Great Western Financial Corporation (financial services), 1986-1997   [193]   None

John J. Nagorniak

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [66]

  Trustee   Indefinite term; Trustee since January 2008   Retired; President and Director – Foxstone Financial, Inc. (consulting), 2000 through December 2007; Director – Mellon Financial Corporation affiliates (investing), 2000 through 2007; Chairman – Franklin Portfolio Associates (investing – Mellon affiliate) 1982 through 2007   [193]   BofA Funds Series Trust (11 funds); Research Foundation of CFA Institute; Director – MIT Investment Company; Trustee – MIT 401k Plan

Catherine James Paglia

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 58

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  Director, Enterprise Asset Management, Inc. (private real estate and asset management company)   [193]   None

Leroy C. Richie

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 69

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  Counsel, Lewis & Munday, P.C. since 2004; former Vice President and General Counsel, Automotive Legal Affairs, Chrysler Corporation (automotive)   [193]   Digital Ally, Inc. (digital imaging); Infinity, Inc. (oil and gas exploration and production); OGE Energy Corp. (energy and energy services)

Minor M. Shaw

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [63]

  Trustee   Indefinite term; Trustee since 2003   President – Micco Corporation [(real estate developer)] and Mickel Investment Group   [193]   Piedmont Natural Gas

Alison Taunton-Rigby

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 66

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

  Chief Executive Officer and Director, RiboNovix, Inc. since 2003 (biotechnology); former President, Aquila Biopharmaceuticals   [193]  

Idera Pharmaceuticals,

Inc. (biotechnology);

Healthways, Inc. (health management programs)

 

(1) If elected to serve on the Columbia Nations Board, the Non-Interested Nominee would oversee [52] funds of the Columbia Fund Complex. If the Non-Interested Nominee also serves or is elected to serve, on the Columbia RiverSource Board, then the Non-Interested Nominee would oversee [141] funds of the RiverSource Fund Complex, for a total of [194] funds across the Combined Fund Complex. The number of funds overseen by each Non-Interested Nominee would be reduced substantially if those board-approved mergers are approved by shareholders of certain funds in the Combined Fund Complex.

 

-68-


Table of Contents

 

Information Regarding the Interested Nominees

Background information regarding each of the Interested Nominees follows.

 

Name, Address and Age

 

Position(s) Held or

to be Held with the

Board Election Fund

 

Term of Office and Length
of Time Served as a Trustee

 

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

  Number of
Portfolios in
Combined Fund
Complex
Overseen or to
Be Overseen(1)
  Other Directorships
Held by Nominee

Anthony M. Santomero(2)

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age [64]

  Trustee   Indefinite term; Trustee since January 2008   Richard K. Mellon Professor Emeritus of Finance, The Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, from 1972 through current; Senior Advisor – McKinsey & Company (consulting), July 2006 through January 2008; President and Chief Executive Officer – Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia, July 2000 through April 2006   [193]   BofA Funds Series
Trust (11 funds);
Renaissance
Reinsurance Ltd.;
Penn Mutual Life
Insurance
Company;
Citigroup, Inc.;
Citibank, N.A.

William F. Truscott(3)

c/o Columbia Management

Investment Advisers, LLC,

53600 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age [49]

  Trustee  

Indefinite term;

None

 

Chairman of the Board, Columbia

Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC) since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, 2001-April 2010); Senior Vice president, [Atlantic Funds, Columbia Funds and Nations Funds] since May 2010; Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President –

Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer, 2005-April 2010 and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, 2001-2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, 2008-April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006

  [193]   None

 

(1) If elected to serve on the Columbia Nations Board, each Interested Nominee would oversee [52] funds of the Columbia Fund Complex. If the Interested Nominee also serves, or is elected to serve, on the Columbia RiverSource Board, then the Interested Nominee would oversee [141] funds of the RiverSource Fund Complex, for a total of [194] funds across the Combined Fund Complex. The number of funds overseen by each Interested Nominee would be reduced substantially if certain board-approved mergers are approved by shareholders of certain funds in the Combined Fund Complex.
(2) CFST currently treats Anthony M. Santomero as an “interested person” of CFST for the reasons set forth above.
(3) William F. Truscott is an “interested person” of CFST for the reasons set forth above.

 

-69-


Table of Contents

 

Nominees’ Beneficial Ownership of Shares of the Board Election Fund

Exhibit F to this combined proxy statement/prospectus provides information, as of [MOST RECENT PRACTICABLE DATE], 2010 (unless otherwise indicated), about the beneficial ownership by the Nominees of shares of the Board Election Fund.

Current Status of Trustees

Messrs. Boudreau, Carmichael, Hawkins, Hilliard, Nagorniak and Santomero and Ms. Shaw were most recently elected to the Columbia Nations Board by shareholders in 2010. Together, such trustees currently comprise the entire Columbia Nations Board. Information about directors/trustees of the Columbia RiverSource Board who are also Nominees is set forth under “Information Regarding the Non-Interested Nominees” and “Information Regarding the Interested Nominees” above.

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

The Columbia Nations Board oversees management of CFST and the Board Election Fund. The Columbia Nations Board has a duty to act in the best interest of shareholders when supervising and overseeing the management and operations of CFST. The Columbia Nations Board currently consists of seven trustees who have extensive and varied experience and skills. Six of the trustees are Non-Interested Trustees. Information about the background and qualifications of each of the Trustees can be found in the sections titled “Information Regarding the Non-Interested Nominees” and “Information Regarding the Interested Nominees” above.

The Columbia Nations Board has appointed William P. Carmichael, an Non-Interested Trustee, to serve in the role of Chairman. The Chairman actively participates in the development of the agendas for Columbia Nations Board meetings, presides at Columbia Nations Board meetings and acts as a liaison with service providers, officers, attorneys, and other trustees generally between meetings. The Chairman may also perform such other functions as may be delegated by the Columbia Nations Board from time to time. Except for any duties specified herein or pursuant to CFST’s governing documents, the designation of Chairman does not impose on such Non-Interested Trustee any duties, obligations or liability that are greater than the duties, obligations or liability imposed on such person as a member of the Columbia Nations Board generally. The Nominees have agreed, if all of the Nominees are elected by shareholders, to appoint Stephen R. Louis, Jr. as Chairman subsequent to the Meeting.

The Columbia Nations Board has several standing committees (the “Committees”), which are an integral part of the Board Election Fund’s overall governance and risk management oversight structure. The standing Committees are the Audit Committee, the Governance Committee, the Contracts Review Committee and the Investment Committee. The roles of each Committee are more fully described in the section titled “Current Committees of the Columbia Nations Board” below.

The Board Election Fund has retained Columbia Management as its investment manager and administrator. Columbia Management provides the Board Election Fund with investment advisory services, and is responsible for its day-to-day management and administration and management of the risks that arise from the Board Election Fund’s investments and operations. The Columbia Nations Board is responsible for overseeing Columbia Management and other service providers in the operation of CFST, including with respect to risk management functions. The Board Election Fund and CFST are subject to a number of risks, including investment, compliance, operational, and valuation risks, among others. Day-to-day risk management functions are subsumed within the responsibilities of Columbia Management, the subadvisers and other service providers (depending on the nature of the risk), who carry out the Board Election Fund’s investment management and business affairs. Each of Columbia Management, the subadvisers and other service providers have their own independent interest in risk management, and their policies and methods of carrying out risk management functions will depend, in part, on their analysis of the risks, functions and business models.

Risk oversight forms part of the Columbia Nations Board’s general oversight of the Board Election Fund and CFST and is addressed as part of various Columbia Nations Board and Committee activities. The Columbia Nations Board recognizes that it is not possible to identify all of the risks that may affect the Board Election Fund or to develop processes and controls to eliminate or even mitigate their occurrence or effects. As part of its regular oversight of CFST, the Columbia Nations Board, directly or through a Committee, interacts with and reviews reports from, among others, Columbia Management, subadvisers, the independent registered public accounting firm for the Board Election Fund, and internal auditors for Columbia Management or its affiliates, as appropriate, regarding risks faced by the Board Election Fund and relevant risk functions. The Columbia Nations Board and the Audit Committee of a Fund also meet periodically with the Board Election Fund’s Chief Compliance Officer to receive reports regarding the compliance of the Board Election Fund and its principal service providers with the U.S. federal securities laws and their internal compliance policies and procedures. The Columbia Nations Board and the Audit Committee have oversight responsibilities with respect to the compliance program of the Board Election Fund and certain of its service providers, and also receive periodic and annual reports from the Board

 

-70-


Table of Contents

Election Fund’s Chief Compliance Officer, as required under applicable regulations. The Columbia Nations Board, with the assistance of the Investment Committee, reviews investment policies and risks in connection with its review of the Board Election Fund’s performance, and meets periodically with the portfolio managers of the Board Election Fund to receive reports regarding the management of the Board Election Fund, including the Board Election Fund’s investment risks. In addition, as part of the Columbia Nations Board’s periodic review of the Board Election Fund’s advisory and other service provider agreements, the Columbia Nations Board may consider risk management aspects of their operations and the functions for which they are responsible.

The Non-Interested Trustees have engaged independent legal counsel to assist them in performing their oversight responsibilities. The Columbia Nations Board reviews its leadership structure periodically and believes that its structure is appropriate because it allows the Columbia Nations Board to exercise informed and independent judgment over matters under its purview, and it allocates areas of responsibility among Committees of trustees and the full Columbia Nations Board in a manner that enhances effective oversight. In particular, the Columbia Nations Board believes that having a Non-Interested Trustee serve as the chair of the Columbia Nations Board and of each Committee promotes independence from Columbia Management in developing agendas and conducting meetings. The Columbia Nations Board believes that its Committee structure makes the oversight process more efficient and more effective by allowing smaller groups of trustees to bring increased focus to matters within the purview of each Committee. The leadership structure of the Columbia Nations Board, including the manner in which it conducts its risk oversight role, may be changed, at any time and in the discretion of the Columbia Nations Board, including in response to changes in circumstances or the characteristics of CFST. In this regard, it may be changed in certain respects as the Columbia RiverSource Board consolidates with the Columbia Nations Board and the combined Board consideres enhancing and reconciling various practices that have historically been different.

Current Committees of the Columbia Nations Board

CFST has four standing Committees, which are the Audit Committee, the Contracts Review Committee, the Governance Committee and the Investment Committee.

In general, the function of the Audit Committee is oversight of the financial aspects of CFST and the Board Election Fund and approval of and interaction with the Board Election Fund’s independent registered accounting firm. Management (which generally means the appropriate officers of CFST, and the Board Election Fund’s investment manager, administrator(s) and other key service providers (other than the independent registered public accounting firm)) is primarily responsible for the preparation of the financial statements of the Board Election Fund, and the independent registered public accounting firm is responsible for auditing those financial statements. Management also is responsible for maintaining appropriate systems for accounting and “internal controls over financial reporting” (as such term is defined in Rule 30a-3 under the 1940 Act), and the independent registered public accounting firm is primarily responsible for considering such internal controls over financial reporting in connection with its financial statement audits. While the Audit Committee has the duties and powers set forth in the Audit Committee charter, the Audit Committee is not responsible for planning or conducting any audits of the Board Election Fund or for determining whether the Board Election Fund’s financial statements are complete and accurate and are in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

The Audit Committee has, among other things, specific power and responsibility to: (i) oversee the Board Election Fund’s accounting and financial reporting processes and practices, its internal controls over financial reporting and, as appropriate, the internal controls over financial reporting of the Board Election Fund maintained by key service providers; (ii) approve, and recommend to the full Columbia Nations Board for its approval in accordance with applicable law, the selection and appointment of an independent registered public accounting firm for the Board Election Fund prior to the engagement of such independent registered public accounting firm; (iii) pre-approve all audit and non-audit services provided to the Board Election Fund by its independent registered public accounting firm, directly or by establishing pre-approval policies and procedures pursuant to which such services may be rendered, provided however, that the policies and procedures are detailed as to the particular service and the Audit Committee is informed of each service, and such policies do not include the delegation to management of the Audit Committee’s responsibilities under the Exchange Act or applicable rules or listing requirements; and (iv) pre-approve all non-audit services provided by the Board Election Fund’s independent registered public accounting firm to the Board Election Fund’s investment manager and any entity controlling, controlled by, or under common control with the investment manager that provides ongoing services to the Board Election Fund, if the engagement relates directly to the operations and financial reporting of the Board Election Fund. The members of the Audit Committee are William A. Hawkins (Chair), Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. and William P. Carmichael. The Audit Committee members are all Non-Interested Trustees. The Audit Committee met on [five] occasions during the fiscal years ended February 28, 2010 and March 31, 2010.

The primary responsibilities of the Contracts Review Committee, as set forth in its charter, include reviewing and making recommendations to the Columbia Nations Board as to: (i) contractual arrangements; (ii) the factors considered in approving investment advisory and the investment subadvisory agreements; and (iii) service provider oversight and performance. Among other

 

-71-


Table of Contents

responsibilities, the Contracts Review Committee also oversees and coordinates activities of consultants and legal or financial experts that may be engaged under certain circumstances. The members of the Contracts Review Committee are R. Glenn Hilliard (Chair), William P. Carmichael, John J. Nagorniak and Anthony M. Santomero. With the exception of Mr. Santomero, an interested Trustee who is not a director, officer or employee of Columbia Management or any of its affiliates, the Contracts Review Committee members are all Non-Interested Trustees. The Contracts Review Committee met on [four] occasions during the fiscal years ended February 28, 2010 and March 31, 2010.

The primary responsibilities of the Governance Committee include, as set forth in its charter: (i) nominating Non-Interested Trustees; (ii) overseeing issues of corporate governance for CFST funds; (iii) addressing matters relating to compensation of Trustees who are not current directors, officers or employees of the Board Election Fund’s investment manager or subadviser or any control affiliate thereof, including deferred compensation and retirement policies; and (iv) evaluating the Board Election Fund’s board of trustees and the Columbia Nations Board and its committee structure as often as the Governance Committee deems necessary or desirable to determine whether each is functioning effectively. The Governance Committee is required to determine the nature of the evaluation and its role therein in its sole discretion. The members of the Governance Committee are Minor M. Shaw (Chair), William A. Hawkins, R. Glenn Hilliard and William P. Carmichael (ex officio). The Governance Committee members are all Non-Interested Trustees. The Governance Committee met on [seven] occasions during the fiscal years ended February 28, 2010 and March 31, 2010.

The primary responsibilities of the Investment Committee are, as set forth in its charter, to assist the Columbia Nations Board in carrying out its oversight responsibilities in specific areas of investment management, both by acting as liaison between the full Columbia Nations Board and Columbia Management on investment matters, and by acting on behalf of the Columbia Nations Board with respect to investment issues in extraordinary circumstances when it is impractical to convene a meeting of the full Columbia Nations Board. In carrying out these general responsibilities, the Investment Committee assists the Columbia Nations Board in connection with issues relating to: the investment policies and procedures adopted for the Board Election Fund; appropriate performance benchmarks and other comparative issues; portfolio management staffing and other personnel issues of Columbia Management; investment-related compliance issues; possible exemptive applications or other relief necessary or appropriate with respect to investment matters; and other investment related matters referred from time to time to the Investment Committee by the full Columbia Nations Board. The Investment Committee reports its activities to the full Columbia Nations Board on a regular basis and is responsible for making such recommendations with respect to the matters described above and other matters as the Investment Committee may deem necessary or appropriate. The Chairperson of the Investment Committee is Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Each trustee is a member of the Investment Committee. With the exception of Mr. Santomero, an Interested Trustee who is not a director, officer or employee of Columbia Management of any of its affiliates, the Investment Committee members are all Non-Interested Trustees. The Investment Committee met on [seven] occasions during the fiscal years ended February 28, 2010 and March 31, 2010.

Nominee Qualifications

CFST’s Declaration of Trust does not set forth any specific qualifications to serve as a trustee other than that each trustee shall be an individual of at least 21 years of age who is not under a legal disability. The charter of the Governance Committee also does not set forth any specific qualifications, but does set forth certain factors that the Governance Committee may take into account in considering trustee candidates. The charter of the Governance Committee is provided in Exhibit H. The Governance Committee’s policy with respect to considering trustee candidates recommended by shareholders, and the procedures to be followed by shareholders in submitting such recommendations, are set forth in Section 3 of such charter. The Governance Committee has not established any specific minimum qualifications that must be met by a nominee or specific qualities or skills that the Governance Committee believes are necessary for one or more of the trustees to possess.

The Governance Committee does not have a formal process for identifying and evaluating nominees, including nominees recommended by shareholders. Instead, it follows the process it deems appropriate under the circumstances. Among the attributes or skills common to all trustees are their ability to review critically, evaluate, question and discuss information provided to them, to interact effectively with the other trustees, Columbia Management, other service providers, counsel and the independent registered public accounting firm, and to exercise effective and independent business judgment in the performance of their duties as trustees. Each trustee’s ability to perform his or her duties effectively has been attained through: (i) the individual’s business and professional experience and accomplishments; (ii) the individual’s experience working with the other trustees and management; (iii) the individual’s prior experience, if any, serving on the boards of public companies (including, where relevant, other investment companies) and other complex enterprises and organizations; and (iv) his or her educational background, professional training, and/or other life experiences. Generally, no one factor was decisive in determining that an individual should serve as a trustee.

 

-72-


Table of Contents

 

The following is a summary of the particular professional and other experience of each Nominee that qualifies such Nominee to serve as a trustee of CFST as of the date of this combined proxy statement/prospectus:

Kathleen Blatz. Ms. Blatz has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2006. Ms. Blatz has ten years of judicial experience and substantial other legal and government experience. Ms. Blatz served as an associate justice of the Minnesota Supreme Court from 1996 to 1998 and as Chief Justice of the court from 1998 to 2006. Ms. Blatz served in the Minnesota House of Representatives from 1979 to 1994.

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Mr. Boudreau has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2005. In addition, he has over thirty years of business and consulting experience, primarily in the financial services industry, including as the chief executive of a mutual fund management company.

Pamela G. Carlton. Ms. Carlton has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2007. Ms. Carlton has significant experience in consulting and in investments, having served as a Managing Director in U.S. Equity Research at J.P. Morgan Chase.

William P. Carmichael. Mr. Carmichael has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 1999, and has served as Chairman of the Columbia Nations Board and of the boards of the other trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2003. Mr. Carmichael served in various senior financial and directorship positions with global consumer products companies. Mr. Carmichael is a certified public accountant and a licensed attorney.

Patricia M. Flynn. Ms. Flynn has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2004. Ms. Flynn currently serves as Trustee Professor of Economics and Management of Bentley University, and was the former dean of a graduate school of business.

William A. Hawkins. Mr. Hawkins has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2005. He currently serves as the President and Chief Executive Officer of California General Bank and has over thirty years of executive level experience in the banking industry. Mr. Hawkins is a certified financial planner and a chartered property and casualty underwriter, as well as holding series 7, 24 and 63 licenses from the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

R. Glenn Hilliard. Mr. Hilliard has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2005. Mr. Hilliard is currently the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of The Hilliard Group, LLC. Mr. Hilliard has over five years executive level experience in the insurance industry. Mr. Hilliard has served on the board of directors and as non-executive chairman of Conseco, Inc. for a number of years. Mr. Hilliard is also a licensed attorney.

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr. Mr. Lewis has been the Chairperson of the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2007 and a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2002. From 1987 to 2002, Mr. Lewis served as President of Carleton College, after which he continued to serve as President Emeritus and Professor Emeritus of Economics. Mr. Lewis has more than thirty years experience in Asia and Africa, primarily advising governments on economic policy and negotiations of foreign investment and financing agreements. Mr. Lewis is also a director of Valmont Industries, Inc.

John F. Maher. Mr. Maher has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2008. Mr. Maher has extensive experience in the financial services industry, and was formerly President, Chief Executive Officer and a director of Great Western Financial Corporation.

John J. Nagorniak. Mr. Nagorniak has been a trustee of the trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2008. Mr. Nagorniak has served in executive level and director positions for over twenty-five years. He is a chartered financial analyst and is currently a trustee of the Research Foundation of the CFA Institute.

Catherine James Paglia. Ms. Paglia has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2004. Ms. Paglia has extensive experience in the asset management industry, and currently serves as a director of Enterprise Asset Management, Inc., a private real estate and asset management company.

 

-73-


Table of Contents

 

Leroy C. Richie. Mr. Richie has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2008. Mr. Richie has over twenty years of legal experience, including, currently, as Counsel at Lewis & Munday, P.C., and formerly served as Vice President and General Counsel, Automotive Legal Affairs, of Chrysler Corporation from 1990 to 1997.

Anthony M. Santomero. Dr. Santomero has been a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2008. Dr. Santomero has over thirty years of experience as a professor of finance and private consultant specializing in issues including risk management, financial restructuring, credit risk evaluation and management, and regulation. He has served as consultant to financial institutions and agencies in the U.S. and various countries in the European Union and the European Community itself, as well as institutions in various countries around the world. Additionally, Dr. Santomero has served as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia.

Minor M. Shaw. Ms. Shaw has served as a trustee of certain trusts in the Columbia Fund Complex since 2003. Ms. Shaw is the President of certain private companies and is a member of the board of Piedmont Natural Gas and Blue Cross and Blue Shield of South Carolina. Ms. Shaw also serves as an active member on the boards of numerous educational and public service organizations.

Alison Taunton-Rigby. Ms. Taunton-Rigby has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2002. Ms. Taunton-Rigby has been the Chief Executive Officer and a director of RiboNovix, Inc. since 2003. She also formerly served as the President of Aquila Biopharmaceuticals.

William F. Truscott. Mr. Truscott has been a director/trustee on the Columbia RiverSource Board since 2001. Mr. Truscott has over nine years of experience as President and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management, and currently serves as Chairman of the board of Columbia Management. Mr. Truscott is also an executive officer of Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of Columbia Management.

Procedures for Communications to the Columbia Nations Board

Shareholders who want to communicate with the Columbia Nations Board or an individual trustee should send written communications to c/o The Secretary of Columbia Funds Series Trust, One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, addressed to the Board of Trustees of CFST or the individual trustee. The Secretary may determine not to forward to the Columbia Nations Board or individual trustees any letter that does not relate to the business of the Board Election Fund.

Executive Officers of CFST

Information about the executive officers of CFST is included in Exhibit D to this combined proxy statement/prospectus.

Remuneration for Trustees and Officers

The current trustees, each of whom is not an employee of Columbia Management or its affiliates, each receive an annual retainer fee of $110,000, which is shared by all of the Funds overseen by such trustees. In addition, the current trustees are currently paid a total of $15,000 per Columbia Nations Board meeting ($2,500 for telephonic attendance at certain meetings), the amount of which is shared by all of the Funds overseen by such trustees. The chairs of the Columbia Nations Board and its committees receive additional compensation for serving in such capacities. The trustees are also reimbursed for the expenses of attending meetings. Persons who are employees, officers or directors of Columbia Management receive no renumeration for serving as trustees of CFST.

Under the terms of the Columbia Nations Board’s Deferred Compensation Agreement, each eligible trustee may elect, on an annual basis, to defer receipt of all or a portion of compensation payable to him or her for service as trustee for that calendar year. Fees deferred by a trustee are credited to a book reserve account established by the Board Election Fund, the value of which is derived from the rate of return of one or more of a subset of the funds in the Combined Fund Complex selected by the trustee (with accruals to such account beginning at such time as a trustee’s elections having been established, and fees for service having been paid into such account, and terminating at such time as when proceeds become payable to such trustee under the Deferred Compensation Agreement). Trustees may change their elections only in accordance with the provisions of the Deferred Compensation Agreement.

Distributions from a trustee’s book reserve account will be paid by check, either in a lump sum or in annual installments. Payments made in annual installments are disbursed over a period of up to ten years, following such time as a trustee may qualify to receive such payments. If a deferring trustee dies prior to or after the commencement of the disbursement of amounts accrued in his/her book reserve account, the balance of the account will be distributed to his/her designated beneficiary either in lump sum or in

 

-74-


Table of Contents

annual payments as established by such trustee himself/herself, his/her beneficiary or his/her estate. Amounts payable under the Deferred Compensation Agreement are not funded or secured in any way, and each deferring trustee has the status of an unsecured creditor of the funds overseen by such trustee.

Total fees paid by the Board Election Fund to its current trustees for its last fiscal year are outlined in Exhibit E to this combined proxy statement/prospectus.

Columbia Management pays all salaries of officers of CFST, except for the Board Election Fund’s Chief Compliance Officer, a portion of whose salary is paid by CFST.

Required Vote and Recommendation

Election of trustees requires the vote of a plurality of the votes cast at the Meeting by or on behalf of shareholders of CFST at which a quorum is present or represented by proxy.

THE BOARD OF CFST UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT YOU VOTE FOR THE ELECTION OF EACH NOMINEE.

 

-75-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION C — PROXY VOTING AND SHAREHOLDER MEETING INFORMATION

Voting. Shareholders of record of each Selling Fund on December 17, 2010 (the “Record Date”) are entitled to vote at the Meeting. With respect to each Reorganization, shares of each of Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund and Columbia Disciplined Value Fund are entitled to one vote for each dollar of net asset value, or a proportional fractional vote for each fractional dollar, represented by those shares on the Record Date, and shares of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II are entitled to one vote per share or a proportionate fractional vote for each fractional share. [[All share classes of a Selling Fund will vote together as one class on the Selling Fund’s proposed Reorganization]]. With respect to the election of Nominees, shareholders of the Board Election Fund will vote together with shareholders of each other series of Columbia Funds Series Trust as a single class. For Columbia Funds Series Trust, there is no cumulative voting in the election of trustees.

Quorum and Methods of Tabulation. A quorum is required for shareholders of a Selling Fund to take action at the Meeting. For Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote, present at the Meeting in person or by proxy, constitutes a quorum. For Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund and Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, thirty percent (30%) of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote, present at the Meeting in person or by proxy, constitutes a quorum.

All shares represented at the Meeting in person or by proxy will be counted for purposes of establishing a quorum. Broker non-votes will be counted for purposes of establishing a quorum but not toward the approval of any proposal or the election of Nominees. (Broker non-votes are shares for which the underlying owner has not voted and the broker holding the shares does not have authority to vote.) With respect to the election of Nominees, neither abstentions nor broker non-votes will have an effect on the outcome of the proposal. With respect to each Reorganization, abstentions and broker non-votes will have the effect of votes against the proposal. In certain circumstances in which a Fund has received sufficient votes to approve a Reorganization, the Fund may request that brokers and nominees, in their discretion, withhold submission of broker non-votes in order to avoid the need for solicitation of additional votes in favor of the proposal. A Fund may also request that selected brokers and nominees, in their discretion, submit broker non-votes, if doing so is necessary to obtain a quorum.

If your shares are held in an IRA account with Ameriprise Trust Company as custodian (the “IRA Custodian”), you have the right to instruct the IRA Custodian how to vote those shares. For each applicable Selling Fund, the IRA Custodian will vote any shares for which it has not received voting instructions in proportionately the same manner as other shareholders of that Selling Fund have voted.

Proxy Solicitation. If you properly authorize your proxy by internet or telephone, or by executing and returning the enclosed proxy card by mail, and your proxy is not subsequently revoked, your vote will be cast at the Meeting and at any postponement or adjournment thereof. If you give instructions, your vote will be cast in accordance with your instructions. If you return your signed proxy card without instructions, your vote will be cast in favor of the Reorganization of your Selling Fund and, for the Board Election Fund, your vote will be cast FOR the election of each Nominee.

Proxy Statement Delivery. “Householding” is the term used to describe the practice of delivering one copy of a document to a household of shareholders instead of delivering one copy of a document to each shareholder in the household. Certain shareholders of the Selling Funds who share a common address and who have not opted out of the householding process may receive a single copy of the combined proxy statement/prospectus along with the proxy cards. If you received more than one copy of the combined proxy statement/prospectus, you may elect to household in the future if permitted by your financial intermediary. Contact the financial intermediary through which you purchased your shares to determine whether householding is an option for your account. If you received a single copy of the combined proxy statement/prospectus, you may opt out of householding in the future by contacting your financial intermediary.

An additional copy of this combined proxy statement/prospectus may be obtained by writing to [•] at [•] or by calling the Selling Funds’ proxy solicitor, [•], toll free, at [•].

Revoking Your Proxy. If you execute, date and submit a proxy card with respect to your Selling Fund, you may revoke your proxy prior to the meeting by providing written notice to the Funds’ proxy solicitor at [•], or change your vote by submitting a subsequently executed and dated proxy card, by authorizing your proxy by internet or telephone on a later date or by attending the Meeting and casting your vote in person. If you authorize your proxy by internet or telephone, you may change your instructions prior to the meeting by authorizing a subsequent proxy by internet or telephone or by completing, signing and returning a proxy card dated as of a date that is later than your last internet or telephone proxy authorization or by attending the Meeting and casting your vote in person. Merely attending the Meeting without voting will not revoke your prior proxy.

 

-76-


Table of Contents

 

Simultaneous Meetings. The meeting for each Selling Fund will be held simultaneously with the meeting for each other Selling Fund, with each proposal being voted on separately by the shareholders of the relevant Selling Fund. If any shareholder objects to the holding of simultaneous meetings, the shareholder may move for an adjournment of his or her Selling Fund’s meeting to a time after the Meeting so that a meeting for that Selling Fund may be held separately. If a shareholder makes this motion, the persons named as proxies will take into consideration the reasons for the objection in deciding whether to vote in favor of the adjournment, and may vote for or against the adjournment in their discretion.

Solicitation of Proxies. The Board of each Selling Fund is asking for your vote and for you to vote as promptly as possible. The expenses of the solicitation will be allocated to each Fund subject to the limitations described in Exhibit A. Proxies will be solicited primarily through the mailing of the Prospectus/Proxy Statement and its enclosures, but proxies also may be solicited through further mailings, telephone calls, personal interviews or e-mail by officers of each Selling Fund or by employees or agents of Columbia Management and its affiliated companies. In addition, Computershare Fund Services, 280 Oser Avenue, Hauppauge, NY 1178, has been engaged to assist in the solicitation of proxies, at the estimated cost set forth below, plus expenses.

 

Fund

   Estimated Cost  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

   $ [ •] 

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

   $ [ •] 

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

   $ [ •] 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ [ •] 

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

   $ [ •] 

Shareholder Proposals. The Selling Funds do not hold annual meetings of shareholders. Shareholders who wish to make a proposal not involving the nomination of a person for election as a director or trustee at a Selling Fund’s next special meeting that may be included in the Selling Fund’s proxy materials must notify the relevant Selling Fund a reasonable amount of time before the Selling Fund begins to print and mail its proxy materials. The fact that a Selling Fund receives such a shareholder proposal in a timely manner does not ensure inclusion of the proposal in the proxy materials, because there are other requirements in the proxy rules relating to such inclusion.

Dissenters’ Right of Appraisal. Shareholders of Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Disciplined Value Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II have no appraisal or dissenters’ rights.

Other Business. The Board of each Selling Fund does not know of any matters to be presented at the Meeting other than the Reorganizations and the election of Nominees. If other business should properly come before the Meeting, the persons named as proxies will vote thereon in their discretion.

Adjournment. If the quorum required for the Meeting has not been met for any Selling Fund, the persons named as proxies may propose adjournment of the Meeting and vote all shares that they are entitled to vote in favor of such adjournment. If the quorum required for the Meeting has been met, but sufficient votes in favor of one or more proposals are not received by the time scheduled for the Meeting, then the persons named as proxies may move for one or more adjournments of the Meeting as to one or more proposals to allow further solicitation of shareholders. The procedures for adjournment of the Meeting for each Selling Fund are as follows:

 

 

For Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund and Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, the Meeting may be adjourned by a majority of the votes properly cast upon the question, whether or not a quorum is present, and the Meeting may be held as adjourned within a reasonable time after the date set for the original Meeting without further notice.

 

 

For Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, the Meeting may be adjourned, whether or not a quorum is present, by the vote of a majority of the shares represented at the Meeting, either in person or by proxy. If the Meeting is adjourned, notice does not need to be given of the adjourned Meeting date unless a new record date for the adjourned Meeting is set or unless the adjourned Meeting is to take place more than sixty (60) days from the date set for the original Meeting, in which case the Board would be required to set a new record date.

 

-77-


Table of Contents

 

The persons named as proxies will vote in favor of adjournment with respect to a proposal those shares they are entitled to vote in favor of such proposal. They will vote against any such adjournment those shares they are required to vote against such proposal. The costs of any additional solicitation and of any adjourned Meeting will be borne in the same manner as the other expenses of the Reorganizations. Any proposal for which sufficient favorable votes have been received may be acted upon and considered final regardless of whether the Meeting is adjourned to permit additional solicitation with respect to any other proposal.

 

-78-


Table of Contents

 

SECTION D — CAPITALIZATION, OWNERSHIP OF FUND SHARES AND FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

This section contains the following information about the Buying Funds and the Selling Funds (all information is shown for the most recently ended fiscal year unless otherwise noted):

 

Table

    

Content

D-1

     Current and pro forma capitalization of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund

D-2

     Current and pro forma ownership of shares of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund

D-3

     Financial highlights of each Buying Fund

The Funds’ Investment Manager and Distributor. Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the investment manager for each Fund. Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111 is the distributor for each Fund.

Capitalization of Selling Funds and Buying Funds

The following table shows the capitalization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I as of August 31, 2010, and of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund and Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund as of September 30, 2010 and, with respect to the Buying Fund, on a pro forma basis, assuming the proposed Reorganization had taken place as of that date. The pro forma combined net assets are determined by adding the net assets of the Selling Funds and the net assets of the Buying Fund. The pro forma combined shares outstanding are determined by dividing the net assets of the Selling Funds by the net asset value per share of the Buying Fund and adding the actual shares outstanding of the Buying Fund.

Table D-1. Current and Pro Forma Capitalization of each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund

 

Fund

   Net assets      Net asset value
per share
     Shares
outstanding
 

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 268,522       $ 19.81         13,553   

Class C

   $ 142,280       $ 19.67         7,232   

Class Z

   $ 119,247,061       $ 19.80         6,023,337   

Total

   $ 119,657,863            6,044,122   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 118,384,246       $ 10.81         10,954,321   

Class B

   $ 1,700,348       $ 10.43         162,992   

Class C

   $ 2,137,343       $ 10.43         204,919   

Class Z

   $ 891,003,080       $ 10.78         82,633,168   

Total

   $ 1,013,225,017            93,955,400   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Pro Forma Combined Fund)**

        

Class A

   $ 118,651,223       $ 10.81         10,979,153   

Class B

   $ 1,700,327       $ 10.43         162,992   

Class C

   $ 2,279,550       $ 10.43         218,556   

Class Z

   $ 1,010,199,548       $ 10.78         93,691,371   

Total

   $ 1,132,830,648            105,052,072   

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 1,033,370       $ 10.62         97,339   

Class C

   $ 229,461       $ 10.48         21,896   

Class Z

   $ 88,384,816       $ 10.62         8,321,838   

Total

   $ 89,647,647            8,441,073   

 

-79-


Table of Contents

Fund

   Net assets     Net asset value
per share
    Shares
outstanding
 

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Selling Fund)

      

Class A

   $ 976,869      $ 13.80        70,763   

Class C

   $ 172,989      $ 13.70        12,629   

Class R

   $ 1,145,651      $ 13.61        84,156   

Class Z

   $ 60,967,481      $ 13.85        4,403,339   

Total

   $ 63,262,990          4,570,887   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

      

Class A

   $ 141,137,302      $ 15.28        9,236,006   

Class B

   $ 19,861,496      $ 14.71        1,350,290   

Class C

   $ 15,994,279      $ 14.71        1,087,017   

Class Y

   $ 9,826,204      $ 15.32        641,569   

Class Z

   $ 525,150,118      $ 15.32        34,284,662   

Total

   $ 711,969,399          46,599,544   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Pro Forma Combined) **

      

Class A

   $ 143,143,098      $ 15.28        9,367,540   

Class B

   $ 19,860,927      $ 14.71        1,350,290   

Class C

   $ 16,396,185      $ 14.71        1,114,370   

Class I

   $ [•   $ [•     [•

Class R

   $ 1,145,567      $ 15.28        74,972   

Class W

   $ [•   $ [•     [•

Class Y

   $ 9,825,922      $ 15.32        641,569   

Class Z

   $ 674,454,901      $ 15.32        44,031,387   

Total

   $ [•   $ [•     [•

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

      

Class A

   $ 111,251,843      $ 8.69        12,798,411   

Class B

   $ 1,999,793      $ 7.62        262,435   

Class C

   $ 2,088,819      $ 7.81        267,585   

Class Z

   $ 188,928,207      $ 9.12        20,723,317   

Total

   $ 304,268,662          34,051,748   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Current) (Buying Fund)

      

Class A

   $ 62,261,175      $ 23.55        2,643,332   

Class B

   $ 2,155,229      $ 22.84        94,351   

Class C

   $ 13,897,374      $ 22.84        608,438   

Class Y

   $ 13,708,034      $ 23.85        574,859   

Class Z

   $ 698,421,575      $ 23.81        29,331,634   

Total

   $ 790,443,387          33,252,614   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Pro Forma Combined) **

      

Class A

   $ 173,478,652      $ 23.55        7,365,984   

Class B

   $ 4,154,388      $ 22.84        181,881   

Class C

   $ 15,985,345      $ 22.84        699,865   

Class I

   $ [•   $ [•     [•

Class R

   $ [•   $ [•     [•

Class Y

   $ 13,707,816      $ 23.85        574,859   

Class Z

   $ 887,282,016      $ 23.81        37,264,079   

Total

   $ [•       [•

 

-80-


Table of Contents

Fund

   Net assets      Net asset value
per share
     Shares
outstanding
 

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 9,109,442       $ 10.09         903,238   

Class B

   $ 1,643,588       $ 9.50         172,968   

Class C

   $ 1,879,191       $ 9.46         198,574   

Class T

   $ 69,025,236       $ 10.09         6,844,289   

Class Z

   $ 126,171,966       $ 10.36         12,184,353   

Total

   $ 207,829,423            20,303,422   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Current) (Buying Fund)

        

Class A

   $ 3,009,345       $ 8.19         367,645   

Class B

   $ 225,501       $ 8.12         27,754   

Class C

   $ 93,969       $ 8.09         11,609   

Class I

   $ 69,800,213       $ 8.23         8,484,965   

Class R*

   $ 8,174       $ 8.17         1,000   

Class R4

   $ 14,880       $ 8.20         1,814   

Class W

   $ 173,685,076       $ 8.19         21,218,876   

Class Z

   $ 2,501       $ 8.23         304   

Total

   $ 246,839,659            30,113,967   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Pro Forma Combined)**

        

Class A

   $ 12,115,701       $ 8.19         1,479,549   

Class B

   $ 1,868,547       $ 8.12         230,101   

Class C

   $ 1,972,548       $ 8.09         243,820   

Class I

   $ 69,797,024       $ 8.23         8,484,965   

Class R*

   $ 8,174       $ 8.17         1,000   

Class R4

   $ 14,879       $ 8.20         1,814   

Class T

   $ 69,002,897       $ 8.19         8,425,262   

Class W

   $ 173,677,139       $ 8.19         21,218,876   

Class Z

   $ 126,133,634       $ 8.23         15,326,080   

Total

   $ 454,590,543            55,411,467   

 

* Class R shares of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.
** Pro forma figures reflect the effect of estimated Reorganization costs.

Ownership of Selling Fund and Buying Fund Shares

The following table provides information on each person who may be deemed to be a “control person” (as that term is defined in the 1940 Act) of a Fund as of December 17, 2010 because it owns, directly or indirectly, of record more than 25% of the outstanding shares of the Fund, by virtue of its fiduciary roles with respect to its clients or otherwise. A control person may be able to facilitate shareholder approval of proposals it favors and to impede shareholder approval of proposals it opposes. In this regard, if a control person owns a sufficient number of a Fund’s outstanding shares, then, for certain shareholder proposals, such control person may be able to approve, or to prevent approval, of such proposals without regard to votes by other Fund shareholders.

[Table to be inserted]

The following table provides information on shareholders who owned of record or, to the knowledge of the Fund, beneficially, more than 5% of any class of a Fund’s outstanding shares as of December 17, 2010. [[As of December 17, 2010, the officers and directors/trustees of each Fund, as a group, owned less than 1% of the outstanding shares of each class of such Fund.]]

 

-81-


Table of Contents

 

Table D-2. Current and Pro Forma Ownership of Fund Shares

 

Fund

   >5% owners   Percent of shares held   Percent of shares
held following Reorganization
 

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class B

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Selling Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class R

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class B

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class I

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class R

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class W

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class Y

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class B

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     N/A   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class B

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class C

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class I

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class R

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class Y

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%     [•]%   

 

-82-


Table of Contents

Fund

   >5% owners   Percent of shares held   Percent of shares
held following Reorganization

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%   N/A

Class B

   [•]   [•]%   N/A

Class C

   [•]   [•]%   N/A

Class T

   [•]   [•]%   N/A

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%   N/A

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

 

Class A

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class B

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class C

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class I

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class R*

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class R4

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class T

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class W

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

Class Z

   [•]   [•]%   [•]%

 

 

* Class R shares of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund were formerly named Class R2 shares.

Financial Highlights

The financial highlights tables below are designed to help you understand how each Buying Fund has performed for the past five full fiscal years or, if shorter, the Buying Fund’s period of operations. Certain information reflects financial results for a single Buying Fund share. The total return line indicates how much an investment in the Buying Fund would have earned each period assuming any dividends and distributions had been reinvested. Total returns do not reflect payment of sales charges, if any. The information shown below with respect to Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, whose report, along with such Buying Fund’s financial statements, is included in such Fund’s annual report to shareholders. The information shown below with respect to Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly, RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund) has been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, whose report, along with the Buying Fund’s financial statements, is included in the Fund’s annual report to shareholders.

Class T shares and Class Z shares of the Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund are new; therefore, no performance information is shown for such shares.

Table D-3. Financial Highlights of Buying Funds

 

-83-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights—Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class A Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Period Ended
February 29,
2008(a)(b)(c)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(a)(d)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.48      $ 7.95      $ 13.66      $ 14.86      $ 13.35      $ 12.00      $ 11.55   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment
income(e)

     0.02        0.08        0.13        0.11        0.14        0.11        0.10   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.68     3.57        (5.49     (0.41     1.46        1.35        0.45 (f) 

Total from investment operations

     (0.66     3.65        (5.36     (0.30     1.60        1.46        0.55   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     (0.01     (0.12     (0.10     (0.14     (0.09     (0.11     (0.10

From net realized gains

     —          —          (0.25     (0.76     —          —          —     

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.01     (0.12     (0.35     (0.90     (0.09     (0.11     (0.10

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (g)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.81      $ 11.48      $ 7.95      $ 13.66      $ 14.86      $ 13.35      $ 12.00   

Total return(h)

     (5.73 )%(i)      45.99 %(j)      (40.12 )%(j)      (2.69 )%(i)      12.00     12.19 %(j)      4.71 %(j)(k) 

Ratios to Average
Net Assets/
Supplemental Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.17 %(l)(m)      1.18 %(m)      1.15 %(m)      1.07 %(l)(m)      1.05 %(m)      1.03     1.12 %(n) 

Interest expense

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      —   %(l)(o)      —   %(o)      —          —   %(o) 

Net expenses

     1.17 %(l)(m)      1.18 %(m)      1.15 %(m)      1.07 %(l)(m)      1.05 %(m)      1.03     1.12 %(n) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      —       —          0.06 %(p)      0.03 %(p) 

Net investment income

     0.40 %(l)(m)      0.78 %(m)      1.10 %(m)      0.81 %(l)(m)      0.98 %(m)      0.86     0.89

Portfolio turnover rate

     94 %(i)      165     156     —   %(i)(o)(q)      —          —          —     

Turnover of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio

     —          —          —          98 %(i)      148     106     122

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 118,384      $ 131,652      $ 95,714      $ 172,569      $ 194,203      $ 201,359      $ 213,513   

 

(a) The per share amounts and percentages reflect income and expenses assuming inclusion of the Fund’s proportionate share of the income and expenses of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio.
(b) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 29. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2007 through February 29, 2008.
(c) Effective February 28, 2008, the Fund converted to a stand-alone fund. Prior to February 28, 2008, the Fund operated in a master-feeder structure.
(d) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Investor A shares were renamed Class A shares.
(e) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(f) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was less than $0.01.
(g) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(h) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(i) Not annualized.
(j) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(k) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 4.70%.
(l) Annualized.
(m) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(n) The reimbursement from the investment advisor had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(o) Rounds to less than 0.01%.
(p) Bank of America Corporation assumed certain non-recurring costs. Absent these non-recurring costs, the waiver/reimbursement ratio would have been -% and 0.01% for the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, respectively.
(q) Amount represents results after the Fund’s conversion to a stand-alone structure on February 28, 2008.

 

-84-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class B Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Period Ended
February 29,
2008(a)(b)(c)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(a)(d)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.11      $ 7.71      $ 13.23      $ 14.39      $ 12.95      $ 11.65      $ 11.21   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment income (loss)(e)

     (0.02     —   (f)      0.03        —   (f)      0.03        0.01        0.02   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.66     3.44        (5.28     (0.40     1.41        1.31        0.42 (g) 
                                                        

Total from investment operations

     (0.68     3.44        (5.25     (0.40     1.44        1.32        0.44   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     —          (0.04     (0.02     —   (f)      —          (0.02     —   (f) 

From net realized gains

     —          —          (0.25     (0.76     —          —          —     
                                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          (0.04     (0.27     (0.76     —          (0.02     —   (f) 

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (f)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.43      $ 11.11      $ 7.71      $ 13.23      $ 14.39      $ 12.95      $ 11.65   

Total return(h)

     (6.12 )%(i)      44.74 %(j)      (40.51 )%(j)      (3.34 )%(i)      11.12     11.33 %(j)      3.93 %(j)(k) 

Ratios to Average
Net Assets/
Supplemental Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.92 %(l)(m)      1.93 %(l)      1.90 %(l)      1.82 %(l)(m)      1.80 %(l)      1.78     1.87 %(n) 

Interest expense

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      —   %(m)(o)      —   %(o)      —          —   %(o) 

Net expenses

     1.92 %(l)(m)      1.93 %(l)      1.90 %(l)      1.82 %(l)(m)      1.80 %(l)      1.78     1.87 %(n) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      —          —          0.06 %(p)      0.03 %(p) 

Net investment income (loss)

     (0.36 )%(l)(m)      0.04 %(l)      0.28 %(l)      0.03 %(l)(m)      0.21 %(l)      0.11     0.14

Portfolio turnover rate

     94 %(i)      165     156     —   %(i)(o)(q)      —          —          —     

Turnover of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio

     —          —          —          98 %(i)      148     106     122

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 1,700      $ 2,696      $ 3,300      $ 13,247      $ 25,523      $ 31,542      $ 37,140   

 

(a) The per share amounts and percentages reflect income and expenses assuming inclusion of the Fund’s proportionate share of the income and expenses of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio.
(b) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 29. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2007 through February 29, 2008.
(c) Effective February 28, 2008, the Fund converted to a stand-alone fund. Prior to February 28, 2008, the Fund operated in a master-feeder structure.
(d) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Investor B shares were renamed Class B shares.
(e) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(f) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(g) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was less than $0.01.
(h) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(i) Not annualized.
(j) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(k) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 3.92%.
(l) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(m) Annualized.
(n) The reimbursement from the investment advisor had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(o) Rounds to less than 0.01%.
(p) Bank of America Corporation assumed certain non-recurring costs. Absent these non-recurring costs, the waiver/reimbursement ratio would have been -% and 0.01% for the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, respectively.
(q) Amount represents results after the Fund’s conversion to a stand-alone structure on February 28, 2008.

 

-85-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class C Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Period Ended
February 29,
2008(a)(b)(c)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(a)(d)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.11      $ 7.70      $ 13.23      $ 14.39      $ 12.94      $ 11.64      $ 11.21   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment income (loss)(e)

     (0.02     —   (f)      0.04        0.01        0.03        0.01        0.02   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.66     3.45        (5.30     (0.41     1.42        1.31        0.42 (g) 
                                                        

Total from investment operations

     (0.68     3.45        (5.26     (0.40     1.45        1.32        0.44   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     —          (0.04     (0.02     —   (f)      —          (0.02     (0.01

From net realized gains

     —          —          (0.25     (0.76     —          —          —     
                                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          (0.04     (0.27     (0.76     —          (0.02     (0.01

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (f)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.43      $ 11.11      $ 7.70      $ 13.23      $ 14.39      $ 12.94      $ 11.64   

Total return(h)

     (6.12 )%(i)      44.93 %(j)      (40.58 )%(j)      (3.34 )%(i)      11.21     11.34 %(j)      3.91 %(j)(k) 

Ratios to Average Net
Assets/Supplemental
Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense

     1.92 %(l)(m)      1.93 %(l)      1.90 %(l)      1.82 %(l)(m)      1.80 %(l)      1.78     1.87 %(n) 

Interest expense

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      %(m)(o)      —   %(o)      —          —   %(o) 

Net expenses

     1.92 %(l)(m)      1.93 %(l)      1.90 %(l)      1.82 %(l)(m)      1.80 %(l)      1.78     1.87 %(n) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      —          —          0.06 %(p)      0.03 %(p) 

Net investment income (loss)

     (0.35 )%(l)(m)      0.03 %(l)      0.39 %(l)      0.04 %(l)(m)      0.21 %(l)      0.11     0.14

Portfolio turnover rate

     94 %(i)      165     156     %(i)(o)(q)      —          —          —     

Turnover of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio

     —          —          —          98 %(i)      148     106     122

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 2,137      $ 2,449      $ 1,559      $ 2,168      $ 11,413      $ 14,026      $ 14,899   

 

(a) The per share amounts and percentages reflect income and expenses assuming inclusion of the Fund’s proportionate share of the income and expenses of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio.
(b) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 29. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2007 through February 29, 2008.
(c) Effective February 28, 2008, the Fund converted to a stand-alone fund. Prior to February 28, 2008, the Fund operated in a master-feeder structure.
(d) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Investor C shares were renamed Class C shares.
(e) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(f) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(g) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was less than $0.01.
(h) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(i) Not annualized.
(j) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(k) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 3.92%.
(l) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(m) Annualized.
(n) The reimbursement from the investment advisor had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(o) Rounds to less than 0.01%.
(p) Bank of America Corporation assumed certain non-recurring costs. Absent these non-recurring costs, the waiver/reimbursement ratio would have been -% and 0.01% for the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, respectively.
(q) Amount represents results after the Fund’s conversion to a stand-alone structure on February 28, 2008.

 

-86-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class Z Shares

 

     (Unaudited)
Six Months
Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2010
    Year Ended
February 28,
2009
    Period Ended
February 29,
2008(a)(b)(c)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2007(a)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2006(a)(d)
    Year Ended
March 31,
2005(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 11.45      $ 7.93      $ 13.66      $ 14.88      $ 13.39      $ 12.03      $ 11.58   

Income from Investment Operations:

              

Net investment
income(e)

     0.04        0.11        0.16        0.15        0.17        0.14        0.13   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     (0.69     3.55        (5.48     (0.41     1.47        1.36        0.45 (f) 
                                                        

Total from investment operations

     (0.65     3.66        (5.32     (0.26     1.64        1.50        0.58   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

              

From net investment income

     (0.02     (0.14     (0.16     (0.20     (0.15     (0.14     (0.13

From net realized gains

     —          —          (0.25     (0.76     —          —          —     
                                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.02     (0.14     (0.41     (0.96     (0.15     (0.14     (0.13

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (g)      —          —          —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 10.78      $ 11.45      $ 7.93      $ 13.66      $ 14.88      $ 13.39      $ 12.03   

Total return(h)

     (5.71 )%(i)      46.30 %(j)      (39.95 )%(j)      (2.43 ) %(i)      12.28     12.50 %(j)      4.98 %(j)(k) 

Ratios to Average Net
Assets/Supplemental
Data:

              

Net expenses before interest expense

     0.92 %(l)(m)      0.93 %(l)      0.90 %(l)      0.82 %(l)(m)      0.80 %(l)      0.78     0.87 %(n) 

Interest expense

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)     
 

 
  
%(m)(o) 
    —   %(o)      —          —     

Net expenses

     0.92 %(l)(m)      0.93 %(l)      0.90 %(l)      0.82 %(l)(m)      0.80 %(l)      0.78     0.87 %(n) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          —   %(o)      —   %(o)      —          —          0.06 %(p)      0.03 %(p) 

Net investment income

     0.65 %(l)(m)      1.03 %(l)      1.35 %(l)      1.06 %(l)(m)      1.23 %(l)      1.11     1.14

Portfolio turnover rate

     94 %(i)      165     156     %(i)(o)(q)      —          —          —     

Turnover of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio

     —          —          —          98 %(i)      148     106     122

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 891,003      $ 988,640      $ 712,304      $ 1,285,598      $ 1,466,653      $ 1,347,623      $ 1,187,622   

 

(a) The per share amounts and percentages reflect income and expenses assuming inclusion of the Fund’s proportionate share of the income and expenses of Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio.
(b) The Fund changed its fiscal year end from March 31 to February 29. Per share data and total return reflect activity from April 1, 2007 through February 29, 2008.
(c) Effective February 28, 2008, the Fund converted to a stand-alone fund. Prior to February 28, 2008, the Fund operated in a master-feeder structure.
(d) On August 22, 2005, the Fund’s Primary A shares were renamed Class Z shares.
(e) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(f) The effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions is included in the net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments (per share). The effect of this reimbursement was less than $0.01.
(g) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(h) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested.
(i) Not annualized.
(j) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(k) Without the effect of the investment advisor’s reimbursement for the Fund exceeding certain investment restrictions, total return would have been 4.70%.
(l) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(m) Annualized.
(n) The reimbursement from the investment advisor had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(o) Rounds to less than 0.01%.
(p) Bank of America Corporation assumed certain non-recurring costs. Absent these non-recurring costs, the waiver/reimbursement ratio would have been -% and 0.01% for the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, respectively.
(q) Amount represents results after the Fund’s conversion to a stand-alone structure on February 28, 2008.

 

-87-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights—Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class A Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 14.62      $ 18.01      $ 21.48      $ 21.22      $ 21.21   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment income (a)

     —   (b)      0.09        0.06        0.07        0.13   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     0.73        (3.42     (1.25     2.97        1.54   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     0.73        (3.33     (1.19     3.04        1.67   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.07     (0.06     (0.07     (0.10     (0.14

From net realized gains

     —          —          (2.21     (2.68     (1.52
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.07     (0.06     (2.28     (2.78     (1.66

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (b)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 15.28      $ 14.62      $ 18.01      $ 21.48      $ 21.22   

Total return (c)(d)

     5.00     (18.44 )%      (7.09 )%      16.33     8.26

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses

     1.25 %(e)      1.24 %(e)      1.22 %(f)      1.23 %(g)      1.24 %(e) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.18     0.23     0.03     0.02     0.01

Net investment income

     0.01 %(e)      0.70 %(e)      0.30 %(f)      0.36 %(g)      0.65 %(e) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     67     117     88     139     82

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 141,137      $ 158,624      $ 225,418      $ 255,743      $ 170,201   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.04%.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.06%.

 

-88-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class B Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 14.12      $ 17.45      $ 20.96      $ 20.81      $ 20.84   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss (a)

     (0.11     (0.01     (0.09     (0.08     (0.02

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     0.71        (3.32     (1.21     2.91        1.51   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     0.60        (3.33     (1.30     2.83        1.49   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.01     —          —          —          —     

From net realized gains

     —          —          (2.21     (2.68     (1.52
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.01     —          (2.21     (2.68     (1.52

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (b)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 14.71      $ 14.12      $ 17.45      $ 20.96      $ 20.81   

Total return (c)(d)

     4.26     (19.08 )%      (7.77 )%      15.50     7.47

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses

     2.00 %(e)      1.99 %(e)      1.97 %(f)      1.98 %(g)      1.99 %(e) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.18     0.23     0.03     0.02     0.01

Net investment loss

     (0.74 )%(e)      (0.05 )%(e)      (0.46 )%(f)      (0.39 )%(g)      (0.10 )%(e) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     67     117     88     139     82

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 19,861      $ 24,933      $ 42,229      $ 53,965      $ 51,446   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.04%.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.06%.

 

-89-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class C Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 14.13      $ 17.46      $ 20.96      $ 20.82      $ 20.85   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss (a)

     (0.11     (0.01     (0.09     (0.08     (0.02

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     0.70        (3.32     (1.20     2.90        1.51   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     0.59        (3.33     (1.29     2.82        1.49   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.01     —          —          —          —     

From net realized gains

     —          —          (2.21     (2.68     (1.52
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.01     —          (2.21     (2.68     (1.52

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (b)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 14.71      $ 14.13      $ 17.46      $ 20.96      $ 20.82   

Total return (c)(d)

     4.18     (19.07 )%      (7.72 )%      15.43     7.46

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses

     2.00 %(e)      1.99 %(e)      1.97 %(f)      1.98 %(g)      1.99 %(e) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.18     0.23     0.03     0.02     0.01

Net investment loss

     (0.74 )%(e)      (0.05 )%(e)      (0.46 )%(f)      (0.40 )%(g)      (0.10 )%(e) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     67     117     88     139     82

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 15,994      $ 19,874      $ 34,208      $ 44,682      $ 43,881   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.04%.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.06%.

 

-90-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class Y Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Period Ended
August 31,
2009(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 14.64      $ 13.32   

Income from Investment Operations:

    

Net investment income (b)

     0.07        0.02   

Net realized and unrealized gain on investments and foreign currency

     0.74        1.30   
                

Total from investment operations

     0.81        1.32   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

    

From net investment income

     (0.13     —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 15.32      $ 14.64   

Total return (c)(d)

     5.51     9.91 %(e) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets / Supplemental Data:

    

Net expenses (f)

     0.83     0.72 %(g) 

Net investment income (f)

     0.43     0.99 %(g) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     67     117 %(e) 

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 9,826      $ 9,630   

 

(a) Class Y shares commenced operations on July 15, 2009. Per share data and total return reflect activity from that date.
(b) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) Not annualized.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(g) Annualized.

 

-91-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class Z Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 14.64      $ 18.06      $ 21.53      $ 21.28      $ 21.27   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment income (a)

     0.04        0.12        0.11        0.13        0.18   

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments and foreign currency

     0.74        (3.44     (1.25     2.96        1.54   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     0.78        (3.32     (1.14     3.09        1.72   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     (0.10     (0.10     (0.12     (0.16     (0.19

From net realized gains

     —          —          (2.21     (2.68     (1.52
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     (0.10     (0.10     (2.33     (2.84     (1.71

Increase from regulatory settlements

     —          —   (b)      —          —          —     

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 15.32      $ 14.64      $ 18.06      $ 21.53      $ 21.28   

Total return (c)(d)

     5.31     (18.26 )%      (6.85 )%      16.62     8.50

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses

     1.00 %(e)      0.99 %(e)      0.97 %(f)      0.98 %(g)      0.99 %(e) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     0.18     0.23     0.03     0.02     0.01

Net investment income

     0.26 %(e)      0.94 %(e)      0.55 %(f)      0.63 %(g)      0.89 %(e) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     67     117     88     139     82

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 525,150      $ 571,175      $ 755,348      $ 859,142      $ 179,027   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.04%.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of 0.06%.

 

-92-


Table of Contents

 

Financial Highlights—Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Selected data for a share outstanding throughout each period is as follows:

Class A Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Period Ended
August 31,
2006(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 20.82      $ 27.82      $ 31.69      $ 30.29      $ 27.47   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(b)

     (0.26     (0.19     (0.24     (0.25     (0.30

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.99        (6.81     0.17        6.38        4.01   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.73        (7.00     (0.07     6.13        3.71   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net realized gains

     —          —          (3.80     (4.73     (0.89

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 23.55      $ 20.82      $ 27.82      $ 31.69      $ 30.29   

Total return(c)

     13.11     (25.16 )%(d)      (1.34 )%(e)      21.96     13.73 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(g)

     1.32     1.37     1.37     1.40     1.46 %(h) 

Interest expense

     —   %(i)      —          —          —   %(i)      %(h)(i) 

Net expenses(g)

     1.32     1.37     1.37     1.40     1.46 %(h) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          0.03     —          —          —     

Net investment loss(g)

     (1.10 )%      (1.01 )%      (0.82 )%      (0.82 )%      (1.15 )%(h) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     144     149     165     151     109 %(f) 

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 62,261      $ 54,384      $ 44,184      $ 18,430      $ 2,836   

 

(a) Class A shares were initially offered on November 1, 2005.
(b) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no initial sales charge or contingent deferred sales charge.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) Total return includes a voluntary reimbursement by the investment advisor for a realized investment loss due to a trading error. This reimbursement increased total return and net asset value per share by less than 0.01% and less than $0.01, respectively.
(f) Not annualized.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-93-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class B Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Period Ended
August 31,
2006(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 20.35      $ 27.39      $ 31.26      $ 30.14      $ 27.47   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(b)

     (0.43     (0.32     (0.45     (0.48     (0.50

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.92        (6.72     0.14        6.33        4.06   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.49        (7.04     (0.31     5.85        3.56   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net realized gains

     —          —          (3.56     (4.73     (0.89

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 22.84      $ 20.35      $ 27.39      $ 31.26      $ 30.14   

Total return(c)

     12.24     (25.70 )%(d)      (2.10 )%(e)      21.05     13.17 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(g)

     2.07     2.12     2.12     2.15     2.21 %(h) 

Interest expense

     —   %(i)      —          —          —   %(i)      —   %(h)(i) 

Net expenses(g)

     2.07     2.12     2.12     2.15     2.21 %(h) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          0.03     —          —          —     

Net investment loss(g)

     (1.84 )%      (1.75 )%      (1.57 )%      (1.57 )%      (1.92 )%(h) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     144     149     165     151     109 %(f) 

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 2,155      $ 2,620      $ 2,812      $ 1,254      $ 521   

 

(a) Class B shares were initially offered on November 1, 2005.
(b) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) Total return includes a voluntary reimbursement by the investment advisor for a realized investment loss due to a trading error. This reimbursement increased total return and net asset value per share by less than 0.01% and less than $0.01, respectively.
(f) Not annualized.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-94-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class C Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Period Ended
August 31,
2006(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 20.35      $ 27.37      $ 31.25      $ 30.14      $ 27.47   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(b)

     (0.44     (0.32     (0.44     (0.48     (0.49

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     2.93        (6.70     0.12        6.32        4.05   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.49        (7.02     (0.32     5.84        3.56   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net realized gains

     —          —          (3.56     (4.73     (0.89

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 22.84      $ 20.35      $ 27.37      $ 31.25      $ 30.14   

Total return(c)

     12.24     (25.65 )%(d)      (2.14 )%(e)      21.02     13.17 %(f) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(g)

     2.07     2.12     2.12     2.15     2.21 %(h) 

Interest expense

     —   %(i)      —          —          —   %(i)      —   %(h)(i) 

Net expenses(g)

     2.07     2.12     2.12     2.15     2.21 %(h) 

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          0.03     —          —          —     

Net investment loss(g)

     (1.85 )%      (1.75 )%      (1.57 )%      (1.56 )%      (1.92 )%(h) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     144     149     165     151     109 %(f) 

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 13,897      $ 10,093      $ 8,382      $ 2,303      $ 427   

 

(a) Class C shares were initially offered on November 1, 2005.
(b) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested and no contingent deferred sales charge.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) Total return includes a voluntary reimbursement by the investment advisor for a realized investment loss due to a trading error. This reimbursement increased total return and net asset value per share by less than 0.01% and less than $0.01, respectively.
(f) Not annualized.
(g) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(h) Annualized.
(i) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-95-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Y Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Period Ended
August 31,
2009(a)
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 21.00      $ 19.21   

Income from Investment Operations:

    

Net investment loss(b)

     (0.17     (0.03

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     3.02        1.82   
                

Total from investment operations

     2.85        1.79   

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 23.85      $ 21.00   

Total return(c)

     13.57     9.32 %(d) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets / Supplemental Data:

    

Net expenses before interest expense(e)

     0.93     1.03 %(f) 

Interest expense

     —   %(g)      —     

Net expenses(e)

     0.93     1.03 %(f) 

Net investment loss(e)

     (0.70 )%      (0.96 )%(f) 

Portfolio turnover rate

     144     149 %(d) 

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 13,708      $ 14,222   

 

(a) Class Y shares commenced operations on July 15, 2009. Per share data and total return reflect activity from that date.
(b) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(c) Total return at net asset value.
(d) Not annualized.
(e) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(f) Annualized.
(g) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-96-


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z Shares

 

     Year Ended
August 31,
2010
    Year Ended
August 31,
2009
    Year Ended
August 31,
2008
    Year Ended
August 31,
2007
    Year Ended
August 31,
2006
 

Net Asset Value, Beginning of Period

   $ 21.00      $ 27.99      $ 31.86      $ 30.36      $ 27.80   

Income from Investment Operations:

          

Net investment loss(a)

     (0.21     (0.14     (0.17     (0.18     (0.29

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments, foreign currency and written options

     3.02        (6.85     0.18        6.41        3.74   
                                        

Total from investment operations

     2.81        (6.99     0.01        6.23        3.45   

Less Distributions to Shareholders:

          

From net investment income

     —          —          —          —   (b)      —     

From net realized gains

     —          —          (3.88     (4.73     (0.89
                                        

Total distributions to shareholders

     —          —          (3.88     (4.73     (0.89

Net Asset Value, End of Period

   $ 23.81      $ 21.00      $ 27.99      $ 31.86      $ 30.36   

Total return(c)

     13.38     (24.97 )%(d)      (1.09 )%(e)      22.28     12.64 %(d) 

Ratios to Average Net Assets/Supplemental Data:

          

Net expenses before interest expense(f)

     1.07     1.12     1.12     1.15     1.20

Interest expense

     —   %(g)      —          —          —   %(g)      —   %(g) 

Net expenses(f)

     1.07     1.12     1.12     1.15     1.20

Waiver/Reimbursement

     —          0.03     —          —          —   %(g) 

Net investment loss(f)

     (0.85 )%      (0.76 )%      (0.57 )%      (0.59 )%      (0.96 )% 

Portfolio turnover rate

     144     149     165     151     109

Net assets, end of period (000s)

   $ 698,422      $ 509,514      $ 354,145      $ 220,887      $ 193,493   

 

(a) Per share data was calculated using the average shares outstanding during the period.
(b) Rounds to less than $0.01 per share.
(c) Total return at net asset value assuming all distributions reinvested.
(d) Had the investment advisor and/or any of its affiliates not waived fees or reimbursed a portion of expenses, total return would have been reduced.
(e) Total return includes a voluntary reimbursement by the investment advisor for a realized investment loss due to a trading error. This reimbursement increased total return and net asset value per share by less than 0.01% and less than $0.01, respectively.
(f) The benefits derived from expense reductions had an impact of less than 0.01%.
(g) Rounds to less than 0.01%.

 

-97-


Table of Contents

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

Class A

 

     Six months ended
March 31, 2010
(Unaudited)
    Year ended
Sept. 30,
 
Per share      2009     2008(a)  

Net asset value, beginning of period

   $ 7.78      $ 9.14      $ 10.16   

Income from investment operations:

      

Net investment income (loss)

     .03        .12        .04   

Net gains (losses) (both realized and unrealized)

     .85        (1.43     (1.06
                        

Total from investment operations

     .88        (1.31     (1.02

Less distributions:

      

Dividends from net investment income

     (.07     (.05     —     

Distributions from realized gains

     (.30     —          —     
                        

Total distributions

     (.37     (.05     —     

Net asset value, end of period

   $ 8.29      $ 7.78      $ 9.14   

Total return

     11.62     (14.23 %)      (10.04 %) 

Ratios to average net assets(b)

      

Gross expenses prior to expense waiver/reimbursement

     1.11 %(c)      1.34     4.14 %(c) 

Net expenses after expense waiver/reimbursement(d)

     1.11 %(c)      1.26     1.28 %(c) 

Net investment income (loss)

     .72 %(c)      1.83     2.91 %(c) 

Supplemental data

      

Net assets, end of period (in millions)

   $ 2      $ 1      $ —     

Portfolio turnover rate

     27     63     6

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

Class B

 

     Six months ended
March 31, 2010
(Unaudited)
    Year ended
Sept. 30,
 
Per share      2009     2008(a)  

Net asset value, beginning of period

   $ 7.71      $ 9.13      $ 10.16   

Income from investment operations:

      

Net investment income (loss)

     .00 (e)      .07        .02   

Net gains (losses) (both realized and unrealized)

     .85        (1.44     (1.05
                        

Total from investment operations

     .85        (1.37     (1.03

Less distributions:

      

Dividends from net investment income

     —          (.05     —     

Distributions from realized gains

     (.30     —          —     
                        

Total distributions

     (.30     (.05     —     

Net asset value, end of period

   $ 8.26      $ 7.71      $ 9.13   

Total return

     11.25     (14.94 %)      (10.14 %) 

Ratios to average net assets(b)

      

Gross expenses prior to expense waiver/reimbursement

     1.88 %(c)      2.10     5.06 %(c) 

Net expenses after expense waiver/reimbursement(d)

     1.88 %(c)      2.02     2.04 %(c) 

Net investment income (loss)

     (.05 %)(c)      1.04     1.48 %(c) 

Supplemental data

      

Net assets, end of period (in millions)

   $ —        $ —        $ —     

Portfolio turnover rate

     27     63     6

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

Class C

 

     Six months ended
March 31, 2010
(Unaudited)
    Year ended
Sept. 30,
 
Per share      2009     2008(a)  

Net asset value, beginning of period

   $ 7.74      $ 9.12      $ 10.16   

Income from investment operations:

      

Net investment income (loss)

     .00 (e)      .07        .02   
                        

Net gains (losses) (both realized and unrealized)

     .84        (1.43     (1.06

Total from investment operations

     .84        (1.36     (1.04

Less distributions:

      

Dividends from net investment income

     (.05     (.02     —     

Distributions from realized gains

     (.30     —          —     
                        

Total distributions

     (.35     (.02     —     

Net asset value, end of period

   $ 8.23      $ 7.74      $ 9.12   

Total return

     11.25     (14.87 %)      (10.24 %) 

Ratios to average net assets(b)

      

Gross expenses prior to expense waiver/reimbursement

     1.87 %(c)      2.12     5.15 %(c) 

Net expenses after expense waiver/reimbursement(d)

     1.87 %(c)      2.01     2.04 %(c) 

Net investment income (loss)

     (.08 %)(c)      1.05     1.37 %(c) 

Supplemental data

      

Net assets, end of period (in millions)

   $ —        $ —        $ —     

Portfolio turnover rate

     27     63     6

 

Notes to Financial Highlights

 

(a) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(b) Expense ratios include the impact of a performance incentive adjustment, if any. In addition to the fees and expenses which the Fund bears directly, the Fund indirectly bears a pro rata share of the fees and expenses of the acquired funds in which it invests. Such indirect expenses are not included in the reported expenses ratios.
(c) Annualized.
(d) The Investment Manager and its affiliates have agreed to waive/reimburse certain fees and expenses (excluding fees and expenses of acquired funds), before giving effect to any performance incentive adjustment.
(e) Rounds to zero.

 

-98-


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit A

Costs of the Reorganizations

Each Selling Fund and the corresponding Buying Fund may bear a portion of the out-of-pocket expenses associated with its Reorganization. Out-of-pocket expenses associated with a Reorganization include, but are not limited to: (1) the expenses associated with the preparation, printing and mailing of any shareholder communications, including this proxy statement/prospectus, and any filings with the SEC and/or other governmental authorities in connection with the Reorganization; (2) the fees and expenses of any proxy solicitation firm retained in connection with the Reorganization; and (3) the legal and other fees and expenses incurred in connection with the Reorganization.

All fees paid to governmental authorities for the registration or qualification of the Buying Fund shares to be issued in the Reorganization and all transfer agency costs related to such shares will be allocated to the Buying Fund. All fees and expenses related to printing and mailing communications to Selling Fund shareholders will be allocated to the Selling Fund. All of the other out-of-pocket expenses of a Reorganization including without limitation, accounting, legal and custodial expenses, will be allocated equally among the applicable Funds. Following this initial allocation among the Funds, Columbia Management limits the expenses actually borne by a Fund to the anticipated reduction in expenses to be incurred by that Fund over the first year following the Reorganization. With respect to Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund only, Columbia Management has agreed to monitor any brokerage commissions attributable to the merger (as distinct from ordinary course transactions) and to bear such commissions to the extent they exceed the estimated brokerage costs that would be associated with the liquidation of such Selling Fund’s portfolio. Any reduction in the Reorganization expenses borne by a Fund as a result of this limitation is absorbed by Columbia Management, not by any other Fund. The estimated costs of each Reorganization expected to be borne by each Selling Fund and each Buying Fund, in the aggregate and on a per-share basis based on shares outstanding as of August 31, 2010, are set forth below:

 

     Costs Estimated to be Borne  

Fund

   Total      Per Share  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 39,773       $ 0.007   

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 0       $ 0.000   

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 33,435       $ 0.007   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

   $ 91,286       $ 0.003   

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 67,260       $ 0.003   

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 12,460       $ 0.000   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 0       $ 0.000   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

   $ 12,544       $ 0.000   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 11,279       $ 0.000   

Should any Reorganization fail to occur, Columbia Management will bear all costs associated with that Reorganization.

Class A, C and Z shares of Columbia Large Cap Core Fund are not expected to benefit from the expense savings as a result of the Reorganizations, but they nevertheless will bear a proportionate share of any reorganization expenses allocated to the Fund.

Based on the operating expense ratios shown in the Fees and Expenses section above for each Buying Fund, it is projected that, after the Reorganizations, assuming all of the Reorganizations are consummated, each class of each Selling Fund will benefit from expense savings that will offset the allocated Reorganization expenses. However, the benefit of those projected expense savings will not be realized immediately. It is projected that the aggregate expense savings for the Selling Funds will not exceed the allocated Reorganization expenses of each Selling Fund until approximately the number of months after its Reorganization set forth below.

 

Fund

   Number of Months  

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

     3   

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

     0   

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

     12   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

     8   

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

     2   

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

If a shareholder redeems his or her shares prior to the indicated time, the shareholder will receive no benefit from the projected expense savings.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit B

Additional Information Applicable to the Buying Funds

Below is information regarding the Buying Funds. All references to a Fund or the Funds in this Exhibit B refer to a Buying Fund or the Buying Funds, respectively, unless otherwise noted.

Fund Management and Compensation (for all Buying Funds)

Columbia Management, 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the investment manager to the Combined Fund Complex (including the Columbia-, RiverSource-, Seligman- and Threadneedle-branded funds), and is a wholly owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial, Inc. In addition to managing investments for the Combined Fund Complex, Columbia Management manages investments for itself and its affiliates. For institutional clients, Columbia Management and its affiliates provide investment management and related services, such as separate account asset management and institutional trust and custody, as well as other investment products. For all of its clients, Columbia Management seeks to allocate investment opportunities in an equitable manner over time. See the Merger SAI for more information.

Subject to oversight by each Fund’s Board, Columbia Management manages the day-to-day operations of each Fund, determines what securities and other investments each Fund should buy or sell and executes the portfolio transactions. Although Columbia Management is responsible for the investment management of each Fund, Columbia Management may delegate certain of its duties to one or more investment subadvisers. Columbia Management may use the research and other capabilities of its affiliates and third parties in managing investments.

The Combined Fund Complex has received an order from the SEC that permits Columbia Management, subject to the approval of each Fund’s Board, to appoint a subadviser or change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for the Fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits the Fund to add or change unaffiliated subadvisers or change the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change. Columbia Management and its affiliates may have other relationships, including significant financial relationships, with current or potential subadvisers or their affiliates, which may create a conflict of interest. In making recommendations to each Fund’s Board to appoint or to change a subadviser, or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement, Columbia Management does not consider any other relationship it or its affiliates may have with a subadviser, and Columbia Management discloses to the Board the nature of any material relationships it has with a subadviser or its affiliates.

Each Fund pays Columbia Management a fee for managing its assets. The fees paid by each Buying Fund for the most recent fiscal year were the following percentage of each Buying Fund’s average daily net assets:

 

Buying Fund

   Percentage of Fund’s Average
Daily Net Assets
 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

     [ •]% 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

     [ •]% 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

     [ •]% 

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

     [ •]% 

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

For Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, the fee structure includes an adjustment in the form of a performance incentive arrangement. The adjustment is computed by comparing the Fund’s performance to the performance of an index of comparable funds published by Lipper Inc. The index against which the Fund’s performance is currently measured for purposes of the performance incentive adjustment is the Lipper Large-Cap Value Funds Index. In certain circumstances, the Fund’s Board may approve a change in the index. The maximum adjustment (increase or decrease) is 0.12% of the Fund’s average net assets on an annual basis. The Board of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund has approved a revised investment management services fee arrangement that eliminates the performance incentive adjustment. This revised arrangement is subject to approval by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, which is being solicited separately.

Under its Investment Management Services Agreement (the “IMS Agreement”), each Buying Fund also pays taxes, brokerage commissions and nonadvisory expenses. A discussion regarding the basis for each Fund’s Board approving the IMS Agreement is available in the Columbia Large Cap Core Fund annual report for the period ended February 28, 2010, in the Columbia Strategic Investor semiannual report for the period ended February 28, 2010, in the Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I semiannual report for the period ended February 28, 2010 and in the Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund annual report for the period ended September 30, 2009.

Each Fund may from time to time take temporary defensive investment positions that are inconsistent with that Fund’s principal investment strategies in attempting to respond to adverse market, economic, political or other conditions including, for example, investments in money market instruments or holdings of cash or cash equivalents. Investing defensively may prevent a Fund from achieving its investment objective.

Portfolio Managers

Information about the portfolio managers who are primarily responsible for overseeing each Fund’s investments is shown below. The Merger SAI provides more information about each portfolio manager’s compensation, other accounts managed by each portfolio manager and each portfolio manager’s ownership of securities in each Fund.

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Peter Santoro, CFA, Lead manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2004.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since 2003.

 

 

Began investment career in 1996.

 

 

B.A., Amherst College.

Craig Leopold, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2004.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since 2003.

 

 

Began investment career in 1989.

 

 

B.B.A., Adelphi University; M.B.A., Fordham University.

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Emil A. Gjester, Lead Manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2002.

 

 

Director of Columbia Management.

 

B-2


Table of Contents

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since December 1996.

 

 

Began investment career in 1996.

 

 

B.B.A., Pacific Lutheran University; M.B.A., University of Cambridge.

Jonas Patrikson, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2006.

 

 

Vice President of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since September 2004.

 

 

Began investment career in 1990

 

 

B.A., Linköping University.

Michael T. Welter, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2006.

 

 

Vice President of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since July 2006.

 

 

Research Analyst at Engemann Asset Management from September 2000 to June 2006.

 

 

Began investment career in 1998.

 

 

B.S., The Wharton School of the University of Pennsylvania.

Mary-Ann Ward, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2008.

 

 

Vice President of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since July 1997.

 

 

Began investment career in 1997.

 

 

B.A., University of Michigan; M.S., University of Wisconsin.

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Wayne M. Collette, CFA, Co-Manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2006.

 

 

Managing Director of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since March 2001.

 

 

Began investment career in 1996.

 

 

B.A., Brandeis University; M.B.A., Columbia University.

George J. Myers, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2006.

 

 

Director of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since October 2004.

 

B-3


Table of Contents

 

 

Began investment career in 1998.

 

 

B.B.A and M.S., University of Wisconsin, Madison.

Lawrence W. Lin, CFA, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2007.

 

 

Vice President of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since December 2006.

 

 

Research Analyst at Primarius Capital from May 2006 to December 2006.

 

 

Research Analyst at Engemann Asset Management from July 1998 to April 2006.

 

 

Began investment career in 1998.

 

 

B.S., University of Southern California.

Brian D. Neigut, Co-manager

 

 

Service with the Fund since 2007.

 

 

Vice President of Columbia Management.

 

 

Associated with Columbia Management or its predecessors as an investment professional since February 2007.

 

 

Portfolio manager at Kern Capital Management LLC from February 2006 to February 2007.

 

 

Portfolio manager at OppenheimerFunds Inc. from November 2003 to February 2006.

 

 

Began investment career in 1995.

 

 

B.B.A., Pacific Lutheran University; studied international business and economics under the William J. Fulbright Scholarship program.

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

The portfolio managers responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund are:

Brian M. Condon, Portfolio Manager

 

 

Managed the Fund since May 2010.

 

 

Joined Columbia Management in May 2010 when it acquired the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, where he worked as an investment professional since 1999.

 

 

Began investment career in 1993.

 

 

B.A., Bryant College; M.S (finance), Bentley College.

Legal Proceedings

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that each Fund is not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial or any of its affiliates is the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on each Fund or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with each Fund. Information regarding certain

 

B-4


Table of Contents

pending and settled legal proceedings may be found in each Fund’s shareholder reports and in the Merger SAI. Additionally, Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the SEC on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

 

B-5


Table of Contents

 

Service Section

Choosing a Share Class

The Funds

Effective September 7, 2010, the Columbia funds (including the portfolios), Columbia Acorn funds and RiverSource funds (including the Seligman and Threadneedle branded funds) share the same policies and procedures for investor services, as described below. For example, for purposes of calculating the initial sales charge on the purchase of Class A shares of a fund, an investor or selling and/or servicing agent should consider the combined market value of all Columbia, Columbia Acorn, RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds owned by the investor or his/her “immediate family.” For details on this particular policy, see Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges – Front-End Sales Charge Reductions.

For purposes of this service section, funds and portfolios bearing the “Columbia” and “Columbia Acorn” brands prior to September 27, 2010 are collectively referred to as the Legacy Columbia funds. The Funds that historically bore the RiverSource brand, including those renamed to bear the “Columbia” brand effective September 27, 2010 as well as certain other funds are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds. Together the Legacy Columbia funds and the Legacy RiverSource funds are referred to as the Funds. References to the “Fund” are deemed to refer to one of the Funds or to one of the Buying Funds25391313_15, as the context requires.

The Funds’ primary service providers are referred to as follows: Columbia Management or the investment manager refers to Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC), the Transfer Agent refers to Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly, RiverSource Services Corporation) and the Distributor refers to Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.).

Additional information about the Funds can be obtained at the Funds’ website, columbiamanagement.com, by calling toll-free 800.345.6611, or by writing (regular mail) to The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 or (express mail) The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809.

Comparison of Share Classes

Share Class Features

Not all Funds offer every class of shares. Each share class has its own investment eligibility criteria, cost structure and other features. You may not be eligible for every share class. If you purchase shares of the Fund through a retirement plan or other product or program sponsored by your selling and/or servicing agent, not all share classes may be made available to you.

The following summarizes the primary features of Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class T, Class W, Class Y and Class Z shares. Although Class B, Class E, Class F and Class T shares are generally closed to new and existing investors, information relating to these share classes is included in the table below because certain qualifying purchase orders are permitted, as described below. When deciding which class of shares to buy, you should consider, among other things:

 

 

The amount you plan to invest.

 

 

How long you intend to remain invested in the Fund.

 

 

The expenses for each share class.

 

 

Whether you may be eligible for a reduction or waiver of sales charges when you buy or sell shares.

FUNDamentalsTM

Selling and/or Servicing Agents

The terms “selling agent” and “servicing agent” refer to the financial intermediary that employs your financial advisor. Selling and/or servicing agents include, for example, brokerage firms, banks, investment advisors, third party administrators and other financial intermediaries.

 

B-6


Table of Contents

 

Each investor’s personal situation is different and you may wish to discuss with your selling and/or servicing agent which share class is best for you. Your authorized selling and/or servicing agent can help you to determine which share class(es) is available to you and to decide which share class best meets your needs.

 

    

Eligible Investors and Minimum Initial Investments(a)

  

Investment Limits

  

Conversion Features

Class A*

   Available to the general public for investment; minimum initial investment is $2,000 for most investors.(e)    none    none

Class B*

   Closed to new investors.(h)    up to $49,999    Converts to Class A shares generally eight years after purchase.(i)

Class C*

   Available to the general public for investment; minimum initial investment is $2,000 for most investors.(e)    up to $999,999; no limit for eligible employee benefit plans.(j)    none

Class E

   Closed to new investors and new accounts.(k)    none    none

Class F

   Closed to new investors and new accounts.(k)    up to $250,000. (l)    Converts to Class E shares eight years after purchase.(i)

Class I*

   Available only to the Funds (i.e., Fund-of-Fund investments).    none    none

Class R*

   Available only to eligible retirement plans and health savings accounts; no minimum initial investment.    none    none

Class R3*

   Effective after the close of business on December 31, 2010, Class R3 shares are closed to new investors; available only to qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, 501(c)(3) charitable organizations, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, 529 plans, and health savings accounts.(n)    none    none

 

B-7


Table of Contents
    

Eligible Investors and Minimum Initial Investments(a)

  

Investment Limits

  

Conversion Features

Class R4*

   Effective after the close of business on December 31, 2010, Class R4 shares are closed to new investors; available only to qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, 501(c)(3) charitable organizations, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, 529 plans, and health savings accounts.(n)    none    none

Class R5*

   Effective after the close of business on December 31, 2010, Class R5 shares are closed to new investors; available only to qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, 501(c)(3) charitable organizations, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, 529 plans, health savings accounts and, if approved by the Distributor, institutional or corporate accounts above a threshold established by the Distributor (currently $1 million per Fund or $10 million in all Funds) and bank trust departments.(n)    none    none

Class T

   Available only to investors who received (and who have continuously held) Class T shares in connection with the merger of certain Galaxy funds into various Columbia funds (formerly named Liberty funds).    none    none

Class W*

   Available only to investors purchasing through authorized investment programs managed by investment professionals, including discretionary managed account programs.    none    none

Class Y*

   Available to certain categories of investors which are subject to minimum initial investment requirements; currently offered only to former shareholders of the former Columbia Funds Institutional Trust.(q)    none    none

Class Z*

   Available only to certain eligible investors, which are subject to different minimum initial investment requirements, ranging from $0 to $2,000.    none    none

 

B-8


Table of Contents
    

Front-End Sales Charges(b)

  

Contingent Deferred Sales Charges (CDSCs)(b)

Class A*

  

5.75% maximum, declining to 0.00%

on investments of $1 million or more.

 

None for money market Funds and

certain other Funds.(f)

   CDSC on certain investments of between $1 million and $50 million redeemed within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months of purchase.(g)

Class B*

   none    5.00% maximum, gradually declining to 0.00% after six years.(i)

Class C*

   none    1.00% on certain investments redeemed within one year of purchase.

Class E

  

4.50% maximum, declining to 0.00%

on investments of $500,000 or more.

   1.00% on certain investments of between $1 million and $50 million redeemed within one year of purchase.

Class F

   none    5.00% maximum, gradually declining to 0.00% after six years.

Class I*

   none    none

Class R*

   none    none

Class R3*

   none    none

Class R4*

   none    none

Class R5*

   none    none

Class T

  

5.75% maximum, declining to 0.00%

on investments of $1 million or more.

   CDSC on certain investments of between $1 million and $50 million redeemed within 18 months of purchase, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months of purchase.(p)

Class W*

   none    none

Class Y*

   none    none

Class Z*

   none    none

 

B-9


Table of Contents
    

Maximum Distribution and Service (12b-1) Fees(c)

  

Non 12b-1
Service Fees(d)

Class A*

  

Legacy Columbia funds: distribution fee up to 0.25% and service fee up to 0.25%;

 

Legacy RiverSource funds: 0.25% distribution and service fees, except Columbia Money Market  Fund, which pays 0.10%.

   none

Class B*

   0.75% distribution fee and 0.25% service fee, with certain exceptions.(c)    none

Class C*

   0.75% distribution fee; 0.25% service fee.    none

Class E

   0.10% distribution fee and 0.25% service fee, with certain exceptions.(c)    none

Class F

   0.75% distribution fee; 0.25% service fee.    none

Class I*

   none    none

Class R*

  

Legacy Columbia funds: 0.50% distribution fee;

 

Legacy RiverSource funds: 0.50% fee, of which service fee can be up to 0.25%.

   none

Class R3*

   0.25% distribution fee    0.25%(m)

Class R4*

   none    0.25%(m)

Class R5*

   none    none

Class T

   none    up to 0.50%.(o)

Class W*

   0.25% distribution and service fees, with certain exceptions.(c)    none

Class Y*

   none    none

Class Z*

   none    none

 

* For money market Funds, new investments must be made in Class A, Class I, Class T, Class W or Class Z shares, subject to eligibility. Class C and Class R shares of the money market Funds are available as a new investment only to investors in the Distributor’s proprietary 401(k) products, provided that such investor is eligible to invest in the Class and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper. The money market Funds offer other classes of shares only to facilitate exchanges with other Funds offering such share classes.
(a)

See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders for more details on the eligible investors and minimum initial and subsequent investment and account balance requirements.

(b)

Actual front-end sales charges and CDSCs vary among the Funds. For more information on applicable sales charges, see Choosing a Share Class – Sales Charges and Commissions, and for information about certain exceptions to these sales charge policies, see Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges.

(c)

These are the maximum applicable distribution and/or shareholder service fees. Because these fees are paid out of Fund assets on an on-going basis, over time these fees will increase the cost of your investment and may cost you more than paying other types of distribution and/or shareholder service fees. For Legacy Columbia funds with Class A shares subject to both a distribution and service fee, the aggregate fees are limited to not more than 0.25%. Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly RiverSource Cash Management Fund) pays up to 0.75% distribution fee and up to 0.10% service fee on Class B shares, and 0.10% distribution and service

 

B-10


Table of Contents
 

fees on Class W shares. Columbia Money Market Fund pays a distribution and service fee of up to 0.10% on Class A shares, up to 0.75% distribution fee and up to 0.10% service fee on Class B shares, and 0.10% distribution and servicing fees on Class W shares. The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive all or a portion of distribution and/or service fees for certain classes of certain Funds. For information on these waivers, see Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees. Compensation paid to selling and/or servicing agents may be suspended to the extent of the Distributor’s waiver of the 12b-1 fees on these specific Fund share classes.

(d)

For more information, see Class R3 and Class R4 Shares – Plan Administration Fees and Class T Shares – Shareholder Service Fees.

(e)

The minimum initial investment requirement is $5,000 for RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund, Columbia Floating Rate Fund and Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund, and $10,000 for Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund, Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund and Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund. For more details on the minimum initial investment requirement applicable to other Funds, see Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders.

(f)

The following Funds are not subject to a front-end sales charge or a CDSC on Class A shares: Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund, and RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund.

(g)

There is no CDSC on Class A shares of the money market Funds or the Funds identified in footnote (f) above. Legacy Columbia fund Class A shareholders who purchased Class A shares without an initial sales charge because their accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase and who purchased shares on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase and redemptions after one year will not be subject to a CDSC.

(h)

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except through reinvestment of dividend and/or capital gain distributions by existing Class B shareholders, or a permitted exchange, as described in more detail under Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders – Buying Shares – Class B Shares Closed. Unless contrary instructions are received in advance by the Fund, any purchase orders (except those submitted by a selling and/or servicing agent through the National Securities Clearing Corporation (NSCC) that are initial investments in Class B shares or that are orders for additional Class B shares of the Fund received from existing investors in Class B shares, including orders made through an active systematic investment plan, will automatically be invested in Class A shares of the Fund, without regard to the normal minimum initial investment requirement for Class A shares, but subject to the applicable front-end sales charge. Your selling and/or servicing agent may have different polices, including automatically redirecting the purchase order to a money market fund. See Choosing a Share Class – Class A Shares – Front-end Sales Charge for additional information about Class A shares.

(i)

Timing of conversion and CDSC schedule will vary depending on the Fund and the date of your original purchase of Class B shares. For more information on the timing of conversion of Class B shares to Class A shares, see Choosing a Share Class – Class B Shares – Conversion of Class B Shares to Class A Shares. Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund do not convert to Class A shares. For information on the timing of the conversion of Class F shares to Class E shares, see Choosing a Share Class – Class F Shares – Commissions and Conversion to Class E Shares.

(j)

There is no investment limit on Class C shares purchased by employee benefit plans created under section 401(a), 401(k), 457 and 403(b), and qualified deferred compensation plans, that have a plan level or omnibus account maintained with the Fund or the Transfer Agent and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper.

(k)

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class E or Class F shares, except that existing Class E and/or Class F shareholders who opened and funded their account prior to September 22, 2006 may continue to invest in Class E and/or Class F shares, as described in more detail under Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders – Buying Shares – Class E and Class F Shares Closed. Class E and Class F shares are designed for investors who wish to make an irrevocable gift to a child, grandchild or other individual.

(l)

If you hold Class F shares of the Fund and your account has a value of less than $250,000, you may purchase additional Class F shares of the Fund in amounts that increase your account value up to a maximum of $250,000. The value of your account, for this purpose, includes the value of all Class F shares in eligible accounts held by you and your “immediate family.” For more information about account value aggregation and eligible accounts, see Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges. If you have reached the $250,000 limit, any additional amounts you invest in Class F shares of the Fund will be invested in Class E shares of the Fund, without regard to the normal minimum investment amount required for Class E shares. Such investments will, however, be subject to the applicable front-end sales charge.

(m)

For more information, see Class R3 and Class R4 Shares – Plan Administration Fees.

(n)

Shareholders who opened and funded a Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 shares account with a Fund as of the close of business on December 31, 2010 (including accounts once funded that subsequently reached a zero balance) may continue to make additional purchases of the share class, and existing Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 accounts may continue to allow new investors or participants to be established in their Fund account. For more information on eligible investors in these share classes and the closing of these share classes, see Buying Shares – Eligible Investors – Class R3 Shares, R4 Shares and Class R5 Shares.

(o)

For more information, see Class T Shares – Shareholder Service Fees.

(p)

Class T Shareholders who purchased Class T shares without a front-end sales charge because their accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of the purchase and who purchased shares on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase and redemptions after one year will not be subject to a CDSC.

 

B-11


Table of Contents
(q)

Class Y shares are available only to the following categories of investors: (i) individual investors and institutional clients (endowments, foundations, defined benefit plans, etc.) that invest at least $1 million in Class Y shares of a single Fund and (ii) group retirement plans (including 401(k) plans, 457 plans, employer-sponsored 403(b) plans, profit sharing and money purchase plans) with plan assets of at least $10 million.

Sales Charges and Commissions

Sales charges, commissions and distribution and service fees (discussed in a separate sub-section below) compensate selling and/or servicing agents, and typically your financial advisor, for selling shares to you and for maintaining and servicing the shares held in your account with them. These charges, commissions and fees are intended to provide incentives for selling and/or servicing agents to provide these services.

Depending on which share class you choose, you will pay these charges either at the outset as a front-end sales charge, at the time you sell your shares as a contingent deferred sales charge (CDSC) and/or over time in the form of increased ongoing fees. Whether the ultimate cost is higher for one class over another depends on the amount you invest, how long you hold your shares and whether you are eligible for reduced or waived sales charges. We encourage you to consult with a financial advisor who can help you with your investment decisions.

Class A Shares — Front-End Sales Charge

You’ll pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class A shares (other than shares of a money market Fund and certain other Funds) unless you qualify for a waiver of the sales charge or you buy the shares through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for more information.

The Distributor receives the sales charge and re-allows (or pays) a portion of the sales charge to the selling and/or servicing agent through which you purchased the shares. The Distributor retains the balance of the sales charge. The Distributor retains the full sales charge you pay when you purchase shares of the Fund directly from the Fund (not through a selling and/or servicing agent). Sales charges vary depending on the amount of your purchase.

FUNDamentalsTM

Front-End Sales Charge Calculation

The following tables present the front-end sales charge as a percentage of both the offering price and the net amount invested.

 

 

The offering price per share is the net asset value per share plus any front-end sales charge that applies.

 

 

The net asset value (or NAV) per share is the price of a share calculated by the Fund every business day.

The dollar amount of the sales charge is the difference between the offering price of the shares you buy (based on the applicable sales charge in the table) and the net asset value of those shares.

To determine the front-end sales charge you will pay when you buy your shares, the Fund will add the amount of your investment to the value of your account (and any other accounts eligible for aggregation of which you or your financial advisor notify the Fund) and base the sales charge on the aggregate amount. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/ Waivers of Sales Charges for a discussion of account value aggregation. There is no initial sales charge on reinvested dividend or capital gain distributions.

The front-end sales charge you’ll pay on Class A shares:

 

 

depends on the amount you’re investing (generally, the larger the investment, the smaller the percentage sales charge), and

 

 

is based on the total amount of your purchase and the value of your account (and any other accounts eligible for aggregation of which you or your financial advisor notify the Fund).

 

B-12


Table of Contents

 

Class A Shares — Front-End Sales Charge — Breakpoint Schedule

 

Breakpoint Schedule For:

   Dollar amount of
shares bought(a)
     Sales
charge as a
% of
the
offering
price(b)
    Sales
charge as
a % of
the net
amount
invested(b)
    Amount
retained
by or
paid to
selling
and/or
servicing
agents
as a %
of the
offering
price
 
Equity Funds and Funds-of Funds (equity)*    $ 0 – $49,999         5.75     6.10     5.00
   $ 50,000 – $99,999         4.50     4.71     3.75
   $ 100,000 – $249,999         3.50     3.63     3.00
   $ 250,000 – $499,999         2.50     2.56     2.15
   $ 500,000 – $999,999         2.00     2.04     1.75
   $ 1,000,000 or more         0.00     0.00     0.00 %(c)(d) 

Fixed Income Funds (except those listed below) and

Funds-of-Funds (fixed income)*

   $ 0 – $49,999         4.75     4.99     4.00
   $ 50,000 – $99,999         4.25     4.44     3.50
   $ 100,000 – $249,999         3.50     3.63     3.00
   $ 250,000 – $499,999         2.50     2.56     2.15
   $ 500,000 – $999,999         2.00     2.04     1.75
   $ 1,000,000 or more         0.00     0.00     0.00 %(c)(d) 

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund,

Columbia Floating Rate Fund,

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund,

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund,

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund and

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

   $ 0 – $99,999         3.00     3.09     2.50
   $ 100,000 – $249,999         2.50     2.56     2.15
   $ 250,000 – $499,999         2.00     2.04     1.75
   $ 500,000 – $999,999         1.50     1.52     1.25
   $ 1,000,000 or more         0.00     0.00     0.00 %(c)(d) 

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund,

Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio,

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund,

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund and

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $

$
$
$
$

0 – $99,999

100,000 – $249,999
250,000 – $499,999
500,000 – $999,999
1,000,000 or more

  

 
 
 
  

    

 

 

 

 

3.25

2.50

2.00

1.50

0.00


   

 

 

 

 

3.36

2.56

2.04

1.53

0.00


   

 

 

 

 

2.75

2.15

1.75

1.25

0.00


%(c)(d) 

Columbia Short-Term Bond Fund and

Columbia Short-Term Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 0 – $99,999         1.00     1.01     0.75
   $ 100,000 – $249,999         0.75     0.76     0.50
   $ 250,000 – $999,999         0.50     0.50     0.40
   $ 1,000,000 or more         0.00     0.00     0.00 %(c)(d) 

 

B-13


Table of Contents

 

 *

The following Funds are not subject to a front-end sales charge or a CDSC on Class A shares: Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund and RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund. “Funds-of-Funds (equity)” includes — Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund, Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund, Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund, Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund, Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund, Seligman TargETFund 2045, Seligman TargETFund 2035, Seligman TargETFund 2025, Seligman TargETFund 2015 and Seligman TargETFund Core. “Funds-of-Funds (fixed income)” includes — Columbia Income Builder Fund, Columbia Income Builder Fund II, Columbia Income Builder Fund III, Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund and Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund. Columbia Asset Allocation Fund, Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II, Columbia Balanced Fund and Columbia Liberty Fund are treated as equity Funds for purposes of the table.

(a)

Purchase amounts and account values may be aggregated among all eligible Fund accounts for the purposes of this table. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/ Waivers of Sales Charges for a discussion of account value aggregation.

(b)

Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of Fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process. Purchase price includes the sales charge.

(c)

Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the Distributor may pay selling and/or servicing agents the following amounts out of its own resources (except for the Funds listed below): 1.00% on purchases from $1 million up to but not including $3 million; 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and 0.25% on amounts of $50 million or more. The Distributor may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are redeemed. Currently, the Distributor does not make such payments on purchases of the following Funds for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more: Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund, Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund and RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund.

(d)

For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the Distributor the following sales commissions on purchases that are coded as commission-eligible trades: 1.00% on all purchases up to but not including $3 million, including those in amounts of less than $1 million; up to 0.50% on all purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and up to 0.25% on all purchases of $50 million or more.

Class A Shares — CDSC

In some cases, you’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class A shares that you bought without an initial sales charge.

 

 

If you bought Class A shares without an initial sales charge because your accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase, you will incur a CDSC if you redeem those shares in accordance with the following policies:

 

   

Columbia fund shareholders who purchased shares of a legacy Columbia fund on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase.

 

   

Fund shareholders who purchased shares after September 3, 2010 will incur a CDSC if those shares are redeemed within 18 months of purchase, which is charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if shares are redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if shares are redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase.

 

 

Subsequent Class A share purchases that bring your aggregate account value to $1 million or more (but less than $50 million) will also be subject to a CDSC if you redeem them within the time periods noted above.

The CDSC on Class A shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower, and

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions.

In certain circumstances, the CDSC may not apply. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for details.

 

B-14


Table of Contents

 

FUNDamentalsTM

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge

A contingent deferred sales charge or CDSC is a sales charge applied at the time you sell your shares, unlike a front-end sales charge that is applied at the time of purchase. A CDSC varies based on the Fund and the length of time that you have held your shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC on shares of a Legacy Columbia fund and, for shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund purchased after the close of business on September 3, 2010, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made. For purposes of calculating the CDSC on shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund purchased on or before the close of business on September 3, 2010, the start of the holding period is the date your purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of investing in the Fund.

Class A Shares — Commissions

The Distributor may pay your selling and/or servicing agent an up-front commission when you buy Class A shares. The Distributor generally funds the commission through the applicable sales charge paid by you. The up-front commission on Class A shares, which varies by Fund, may be up to 5.00% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 5.75%, up to 4.00% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 4.75%, up to 2.75% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 3.25%, up to 2.50% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 3.00%, and up to 0.75% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 1.00%.

The Distributor may also pay your selling and/or servicing agent a cumulative commission when you buy $1 million or more of Class A shares, according to the following schedule:

 

Class A Shares – Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Service Agents)*

 

Purchase Amount

   Commission Level
(as a % of net asset value per  share)
 

$1 million – $2,999,999

     1.00 %** 

$3 million – $49,999,999

     0.50

$50 million or more

     0.25

 

* Not applicable to Funds that do not assess a front-end sales charge.
** For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the Distributor sales commissions on purchases (that are coded as commission-eligible trades) in amounts of less than $1 million.

Class B Shares — Sales Charges

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions involving existing investors in Class B shares as described in more detail below under Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares — Buying Shares — Eligible Investors — Class B Shares Closed.

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class B shares, but you may pay a CDSC when you sell Class B shares.

Class B Shares — CDSC

The CDSC on Class B shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower,

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares, and

 

 

generally declines each year until there is no sales charge for redeeming shares.

 

B-15


Table of Contents

 

You’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class B shares unless you qualify for a waiver of the CDSC or the shares you’re selling were bought through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for details. Also, you will not pay a CDSC on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares. The CDSC you pay on Class B shares depends on how long you’ve held your shares:

 

Class B Shares — CDSC Schedule for the Funds

    

Applicable CDSC*

Number of Years
Class B
Shares Held

  

All Funds except those

listed to the right

  

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond
Fund, Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund,
Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, Columbia
Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond
Fund, Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Oregon
Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,
Columbia Short Term Bond Fund, Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund,
Columbia Total Return Bond Fund and Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

One

   5.00%    3.00%

Two

   4.00%    3.00%

Three

   3.00%**    2.00%

Four

   3.00%    1.00%

Five

   2.00%    None

Six

   1.00%    None

Seven

   None    None

Eight

   None    None

Nine

   Conversion to Class A Shares    Conversion to Class A Shares

 

* Because of rounding in the calculation, the actual CDSC you pay may be more or less than the CDSC calculated using these percentages.
** For shares purchased in a Legacy RiverSource fund (other than a Seligman fund) on or prior to June 12, 2009, the CDSC percentage for year three is 4%.

Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund are not subject to a CDSC.

Class B Shares — Commissions

If you are an investor who purchased Class B shares prior to their closing (except for certain limited transactions), although there was no front-end sales charge for Class B shares when you bought Class B shares, the Distributor paid an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent when you bought the Class B shares (a portion of this

 

B-16


Table of Contents

commission may, in turn, have been paid to your financial advisor). This up-front commission, which varies across the Funds, was up to 4.00% of the net asset value per share of Funds with a maximum CDSC of 5.00% and of Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund and up to 2.75% of the net asset value per share of Funds with a maximum CDSC of 3.00%. The Distributor continues to seek to recover this commission through distribution fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution plan and any applicable CDSC paid when you sell your shares. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

Class B Shares — Conversion to Class A Shares

Class B shares purchased in a Legacy Columbia fund at any time, a Legacy RiverSource fund (other than a Seligman fund) at any time, or a Seligman fund on or after June 13, 2009 automatically convert to Class A shares after you’ve owned the shares for eight years, except for Class B shares of Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund, which do not convert to Class A shares. Class B shares originally purchased in a Seligman fund on or prior to June 12, 2009 will convert to Class A shares in the month prior to the ninth year of ownership. The conversion feature allows you to benefit from the lower operating costs of Class A shares, which can help increase your total returns from an investment in the Fund.

Class B shares purchased in a Legacy RiverSource fund (other than a Seligman fund) prior to May 21, 2005 age on a calendar year basis. Class B shares purchased in a Legacy Columbia fund at any time, Seligman fund at any time, or a Legacy RiverSource fund on or after May 21, 2005 age on a daily basis. For example, a purchase made on November 12, 2004 completed its first year on December 31, 2004 under calendar year aging, but completed its first year on November 11, 2005 under daily aging.

The following rules apply to the conversion of Class B shares to Class A shares:

 

 

Class B shares are converted on or about the 15th day of the month that they become eligible for conversion. For purposes of determining the month when your Class B shares are eligible for conversion, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made.

 

 

Any shares you received from reinvested distributions on these shares generally will convert to Class A shares at the same time.

 

 

You’ll receive the same dollar value of Class A shares as the Class B shares that were converted. Class B shares that you received from an exchange of Class B shares of another Fund will convert based on the day you bought the original shares.

 

 

No sales charge or other charges apply, and conversions are free from U.S. federal income tax.

Class C Shares — Sales Charges

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class C shares, but you may pay a CDSC when you sell Class C shares.

Class C Shares — CDSC

You’ll pay a CDSC of 1.00% if you redeem Class C shares within one year of buying them unless you qualify for a waiver of the CDSC or the shares you’re selling were bought through reinvested distributions. For details, see Choosing a Share Class — Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges. The CDSC on Class C shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower,

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares, and

 

 

is reduced to 0.00% on shares redeemed a year or more after purchase.

Class C Shares — Commissions

Although there is no front-end sales charge when you buy Class C shares, the Distributor pays an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent of up to 1.00% of the net asset value per share when you buy Class C shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor). The Distributor seeks to recover this commission through distribution fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution and/or service plan and any applicable CDSC applied when you sell your shares. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

 

B-17


Table of Contents

 

Class E Shares — Front-End Sales Charge

You’ll pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class E shares unless you qualify for a waiver of the sales charge or you buy the shares through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for more information.

The front-end sales charge you’ll pay on Class E shares:

 

 

depends on the amount you’re investing (generally, the larger the investment, the smaller the percentage sales charge), and

 

 

is based on the total amount of your purchase and the value of your account.

 

Class E Shares — Front-End Sales Charge – Breakpoint Schedule

Dollar amount of

shares bought(a)

 

Sales charge as a % of the
offering price(b)

 

Sales charge as a % of the
net amount invested(b)

 

Amount retained by or paid to selling
and/or servicing agents as a % of the
offering price

$0 – $49,999

  4.50%   4.71%   4.00%

$50,000 – $99,999

  3.50%   3.63%   3.00%

$100,000 – $249,999

  2.50%   2.56%   2.00%

$250,000 – $499,999

  1.25%   1.27%   1.00%

$500,000 – $999,999

  0.00%   0.00%   0.00%

$1,000,000 or more

  0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)

 

(a)

Purchase amounts and account values are aggregated among all eligible Fund accounts for the purposes of this table.

(b)

Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of Fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process.

(c)

Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the Distributor may pay selling and/or servicing agents the following out of its own resources: 1.00% on purchases up to but not including $3 million, 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $5 million and 0.25% on purchases of $5 million or more. The Distributor pays selling and/or servicing agents on investments of $1 million or more, but may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are sold.

Class E Shares — CDSC

In some cases, you’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class E shares that you bought without an initial sales charge.

 

 

If you bought Class E shares without an initial sales charge because your accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase, you will incur a 1.00% CDSC if you redeem those shares within one year of buying them.

 

 

Subsequent Class E share purchases that bring your aggregate account value to $1 million or more (but less than $50 million) will also be subject to a CDSC if you redeem them within one year of buying them.

The CDSC on Class E shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower, and

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares.

 

B-18


Table of Contents

 

For purposes of calculating the CDSC, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which the purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class E shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of your investment in the Funds.

The Distributor may pay your selling and/or servicing agent an up-front commission of up to 4.00% of the offering price per share when you buy Class E shares. The Distributor funds the commission through the applicable sales charge paid by you.

Class E Shares – Commissions

The Distributor may also pay your selling and/or servicing agent a cumulative commission when you buy Class E shares, according to the following schedule:

 

Class E Shares – Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Servicing Agents)

Purchase Amount

   Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per  share)

$0 – $2,999,999

   1.00%

$3 million – $4,999,999

   0.50%

$5 million or more

   0.25%

Class F Shares – Sales Charges

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class F shares, but you may pay a CDSC when you sell Class F shares. The CDSC on Class F shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower,

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or on any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares, and

 

 

generally declines each year until there is no sales charge for redeeming shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class F shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of your investment in the Funds.

Class F Shares – CDSC

The CDSC you pay on Class F shares depends on how long you’ve held your shares:

 

Class F Shares – CDSC Schedule

Number of Years Class F Shares Held

   Applicable CDSC*

One

   5.00%

Two

   4.00%

Three

   3.00%

Four

   3.00%

 

B-19


Table of Contents

Class F Shares – CDSC Schedule

Five

   2.00%

Six

   1.00%

Seven

   None

Eight

   None

Nine

   Conversion to Class E Shares

 

* Because of rounding in the calculation, the actual CDSC you pay may be more or less than the CDSC calculated using these percentages.

Class F Shares – Commissions and Conversion to Class E Shares

Although there is no front-end sales charge when you buy Class F shares, the Distributor pays an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent of up to 4.00% of the net asset value per share when you buy Class F shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor). The Distributor seeks to recover this commission through distribution fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution plan and any applicable CDSC when you sell your shares. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

Class F shares automatically convert to Class E shares after you’ve owned them for eight years. This conversion feature allows you to benefit from the lower operating costs of Class E shares, which can help increase your total returns from an investment in the Fund.

The following rules apply to the conversion of Class F shares to Class E shares:

 

 

Class F shares are converted on or about the 15th day of the month that they become eligible for conversion.

 

 

Any shares you received from reinvested distributions on these shares generally will convert to Class E shares at the same time.

 

 

You’ll receive the same dollar value of Class E shares as the Class F shares that were converted. Class F shares that you received from an exchange of Class F shares of another Fund will convert based on the day you bought the original shares.

 

 

No sales charge or other charges apply, and conversions are free from U.S. federal income tax.

Class R Shares – Sales Charges and Commissions

You don’t pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class R shares of the Fund or a CDSC when you sell Class R shares of the Fund. See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Opening an Account and Placing Orders for more information about investing in Class R shares of the Fund. The Distributor pays an up-front commission directly to your selling and/or servicing agent when you buy Class R shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor), according to the following schedule:

 

Class R Shares – Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Servicing Agents)

Purchase Amount

   Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per  share)

$0 – $49,999,999

   0.50%

$50 million or more

   0.25%

The Distributor seeks to recover this commission through distribution and/or service fees it receives under the Fund’s distribution and/or service plan. See Choosing a Share Class – Distribution and Service Fees for details.

 

B-20


Table of Contents

 

Class T Shares – Front-End Sales Charge

You’ll pay a front-end sales charge when you buy Class T shares unless you qualify for a waiver of the sales charge or you buy the shares through reinvested distributions. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for more information.

The front-end sales charge you’ll pay on Class T shares:

 

 

depends on the amount you’re investing (generally, the larger the investment, the smaller the percentage sales charge), and

 

 

is based on the total amount of your purchase and the value of your account.

 

Class T Shares – Front-End Sales Charge – Breakpoint Schedule

Breakpoint Schedule For:

   Dollar amount of
shares bought(a)
     Sales charge as a %
of the offering
price(b)
  Sales charge as a %
of the net amount
invested(b)
  Amount retained by
or paid to selling
and/or servicing
agents as a % of the
offering price

Equity Funds

     $0 – $49,999       5.75%   6.10%   5.00%
     $50,000 – $99,999       4.50%   4.71%   3.75%
     $100,000 – $249,999       3.50%   3.63%   2.75%
     $250,000 – $499,999       2.50%   2.56%   2.00%
     $500,000 – $999,999       2.00%   2.04%   1.75%
     $1,000,000 or more       0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)
                     

Fixed Income Funds

     $0 – $49,999       4.75%   4.99%   4.25%
     $50,000 – $99,999       4.50%   4.71%   3.75%
     $100,000 – $249,999       3.50%   3.63%   2.75%
     $250,000 – $499,999       2.50%   2.56%   2.00%
     $500,000 – $999,999       2.00%   2.04%   1.75%
     $1,000,000 or more       0.00%   0.00%   0.00%(c)(d)

 

(a)

Purchase amounts and account values are aggregated among all eligible Fund accounts for the purposes of this table.

 

B-21


Table of Contents
(b)

Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of Fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process.

(c)

Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the Distributor may pay selling and/or servicing agents the following amounts out of its own resources: 1.00% on purchases of $1 million up to but not including $3 million, 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million and 0.25% on purchases of $50 million or more. The Distributor pays selling and/or servicing agents on investments of $1 million or more, but may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are sold.

(d)

For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the Distributor the following sales commissions on purchases that are coded as commission-eligible trades: 1.00% on purchases up to but not including $3 million (including those in amounts of less than $1 million), up to 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million, and up to 0.25% on purchases of $50 million or more.

Class T Shares – CDSC

In some cases, you’ll pay a CDSC if you sell Class T shares that you bought without an initial sales charge.

 

 

If you bought Class T shares without a front-end sales charge because your accounts aggregated between $1 million and $50 million at the time of purchase, you will incur a CDSC if you redeem those shares in accordance with the following policies:

 

   

Shareholders who purchased shares of a Legacy Columbia fund on or before September 3, 2010 will incur a 1.00% CDSC if those shares are redeemed within one year of purchase.

 

   

Shareholders who purchased shares of a Fund after September 3, 2010 will incur a CDSC if those shares are redeemed within 18 months of purchase, which is charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if shares are redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if shares are redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months of purchase.

 

 

Subsequent Class T share purchases that bring your aggregate account value to $1 million or more (but less than $50 million) will also be subject to a CDSC if you redeem them within one year of purchase.

The CDSC on Class T shares:

 

 

is applied to the net asset value at the time of your purchase or sale, whichever is lower, and

 

 

will not be applied to any shares you receive through reinvested distributions or any amount that represents appreciation in the value of your shares.

For purposes of calculating the CDSC, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which the purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class T shares, the Fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for U.S. federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of your investment in the Funds.

In certain circumstances, the CDSC may not apply. See Choosing a Share Class – Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges for details.

Class T Shares – Commissions

The Distributor may pay your selling and/or servicing agent an up-front commission when you buy Class T shares (a portion of this commission may, in turn, be paid to your financial advisor). The up-front commission, which varies by Fund, may be up to 5.00% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 5.75% and up to 4.25% of the offering price for Funds with a maximum front-end sales charge of 4.75%.

The Distributor may also pay your selling and/or servicing agent a cumulative commission when you buy $1 million or more of Class T shares, according to the following schedule:

 

Class T Shares – Commission Schedule (Paid by the Distributor to Selling and/or Servicing Agents)

Purchase Amount

   Commission Level (as a % of net asset value per  share)

$1 million – $2,999,999

   1.00%

 

B-22


Table of Contents

$3 million – $49,999,999

   0.50%

$50 million or more

   0.25%

Reductions/Waivers of Sales Charges

Front-End Sales Charge Reductions

There are two ways in which you may be able to reduce the front-end sales charge that you may pay when you buy Class A, Class E or Class T shares of a Fund. These types of sales charge reductions are also referred to as breakpoint discounts.

First, through the right of accumulation (ROA), you may combine the value of eligible accounts maintained by you and members of your immediate family to reach a breakpoint discount level and apply a lower sales charge to your purchase. To calculate the combined value of your accounts in the particular class of shares, the Fund will use the current public offering price per share. For purposes of obtaining a Class A shares breakpoint discount through ROA, you may aggregate your or your immediate family members’ ownership of different classes of shares, except for Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of the Funds, which may not be aggregated.

Second, by making a statement of intent to purchase additional shares (commonly referred to as a letter of intent (LOI)), you may pay a lower sales charge on all purchases (including existing ROA purchases) of Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares made within 13 months of the date of your LOI. Your LOI must state the aggregate amount of purchases you intend to make in that 13-month period, which must be at least $50,000. The required form of LOI may vary by selling and/or servicing agent, so please contact them directly for more information. Five percent of the purchase commitment amount will be placed in escrow. At the end of the 13-month period, the shares will be released from escrow, provided that you have invested the commitment amount. If you do not invest the purchase commitment amount by the end of the 13 months, the remaining amount of the unpaid sales charge will be redeemed from the escrowed shares and the remaining balance released from escrow. To calculate the total value of the purchases you’ve made under an LOI, the Fund will use the historic cost (i.e., dollars invested) of the shares held in each eligible account. For purposes of making an LOI to purchase additional shares, you may aggregate your ownership of different classes of shares, except for Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of the Funds, which may not be aggregated.

You must request the reduced sales charge (whether through ROA or an LOI) when you buy shares. If you do not complete and file an LOI, or do not request the reduced sales charge at the time of purchase, you will not be eligible for the reduced sales charge. To obtain a breakpoint discount, you must notify your selling and/or servicing agent in writing at the time you buy your shares of each eligible account maintained by you and members of your immediate family, including accounts maintained through different selling and/or servicing agents. You and your selling and/or servicing agent are responsible for ensuring that you receive discounts for which you are eligible. The Fund is not responsible for a selling and/or servicing agent’s failure to apply the eligible discount to your account. You may be asked by your selling and/or servicing agent for account statements or other records to verify your discount eligibility, including, when applicable, records for accounts opened with a different selling and/or servicing agent and records of accounts established by members of your immediate family.

FUNDamentals

Your “Immediate Family” and Account Value Aggregation

For purposes of reaching the Class F shares investment limits described in Choosing a Share Class – Comparison of the Share Classes or obtaining a Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares breakpoint discount, the value of your account will be deemed to include the value of all applicable shares in eligible accounts that are held by you and your “immediate family,” which includes your spouse, domestic partner, parent, step-parent, legal guardian, child, step-child, father-in-law and mother-in-law, provided that you and your immediate family members share the same mailing address. Any Fund accounts linked together for account value aggregation purposes as of the close of business on September 3, 2010 will be permitted to remain linked together. Remember that in order to obtain a breakpoint discount, you must notify your selling and/or servicing agent in writing at the time you buy your shares of each eligible account maintained by you and members of your immediate family. Group plan accounts are valued at the plan level.

 

B-23


Table of Contents

 

Eligible Accounts

The following accounts are eligible for account value aggregation as described above:

 

 

Individual or joint accounts;

 

 

Roth and traditional Individual Retirement Accounts (IRAs), Simplified Employee Pension accounts (SEPs), Savings Investment Match Plans for Employees of Small Employers accounts (SIMPLEs) and Tax Sheltered Custodial Accounts (TSCAs);

 

 

Uniform Gifts to Minors Act (UGMA)/Uniform Transfers to Minors (UTMA) accounts for which you, your spouse, or your domestic partner is parent or guardian of the minor child;

 

 

Revocable trust accounts for which you or an immediate family member, individually, is the beneficial owner/grantor;

 

 

Accounts held in the name of your, your spouse’s, or your domestic partner’s sole proprietorship or single owner limited liability company or S corporation;

 

 

Qualified retirement plan assets, provided that you are the sole owner of the business sponsoring the plan, are the sole participant (other than a spouse) in the plan, and have no intention of adding participants to the plan; and

 

 

Investments in wrap accounts;

provided that each of the accounts identified above is invested in Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class W and/or Class Z shares of the Funds.

The following accounts are not eligible for account value aggregation as described above:

 

 

Accounts of pension and retirement plans with multiple participants, such as 401(k) plans (which are combined to reduce the sales charge for the entire pension or retirement plan and therefore are not used to reduce the sales charge for your individual accounts);

 

 

Accounts invested in Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of the Funds;

 

 

Investments in 529 plans, donor advised funds, variable annuities, variable life insurance products, or managed separate accounts;

 

 

Charitable and irrevocable trust accounts; and

 

 

Accounts holding shares of money market Funds that used the Columbia brand before May 1, 2010.

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

The following categories of investors may buy Class A, Class E and Class T shares of the Funds at net asset value, without payment of any front-end sales charge that would otherwise apply:

 

 

Current or retired Fund Board members, officers or employees of the Funds or Columbia Management or its affiliates(1);

 

 

Current or retired Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc. financial advisors and employees of such financial advisors(1);

 

 

Registered representatives and other employees of affiliated or unaffiliated selling and/or servicing agent having a selling agreement with the Distributor(1);

 

 

Registered broker/dealer firms that have entered into a dealer agreement with the Distributor may buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge for their investment account only;

 

 

Portfolio managers employed by subadvisers of the Funds(1);

 

 

Partners and employees of outside legal counsel to the Funds or the Funds’ directors or trustees who regularly provide advice and services to the Funds, or to their directors or trustees;

 

 

Direct rollovers from qualified employee benefit plans, provided that the rollover involves a transfer to Class A shares in the same Fund;

 

 

Purchases made:

 

   

With dividend or capital gain distributions from a Fund or from the same class of another Fund;

 

B-24


Table of Contents

 

   

Through or under a wrap fee product or other investment product sponsored by a selling and/or servicing agent that charges an account management fee or other managed agency/asset allocation accounts or programs involving fee-based compensation arrangements that have or that clear trades through a selling and/or servicing agent that has a selling agreement with the Distributor;

 

   

Through state sponsored college savings plans established under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code; or

 

   

Through banks, trust companies and thrift institutions, acting as fiduciaries;

 

 

Separate accounts established and maintained by an insurance company which are exempt from registration under Section 3(c)(11);

 

 

Purchases made through “employee benefit plans” created under section 401(a), 401(k), 457 and 403(b), and qualified deferred compensation plans that have a plan level or omnibus account maintained with the Fund or the Transfer Agent and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper; and

 

 

At the Fund’s discretion, front-end sales charges may be waived for shares issued in plans of reorganization, such as mergers, asset acquisitions and exchange offers, to which the Fund is a party.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Funds may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your selling and/or servicing agent with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your selling and/or servicing agent provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. Please see the Merger SAI for more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers.

 

(1) Including their spouses or domestic partners, children or step-children, parents, step-parents or legal guardians, and their spouse’s or domestic partner’s parents, step-parents, or legal guardians.

CDSC Waivers

You may be able to avoid an otherwise applicable CDSC when you sell Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F or Class T shares of the Fund. This could happen because of the way in which you originally invested in the Fund, because of your relationship with the Funds or for other reasons.

CDSC — Waivers of the CDSC for Class A, Class C, Class E, Class F and Class T shares. The CDSC will be waived on redemptions of shares:

 

 

in the event of the shareholder’s death;

 

 

for which no sales commission or transaction fee was paid to an authorized selling and/or servicing agent at the time of purchase;

 

 

purchased through reinvestment of dividend and capital gain distributions;

 

 

in an account that has been closed because it falls below the minimum account balance;

 

 

that result from required minimum distributions taken from retirement accounts upon the shareholder’s attainment of age 70 1/2;

 

 

that result from returns of excess contributions made to retirement plans or individual retirement accounts, so long as the selling and/or servicing agent returns the applicable portion of any commission paid by the Distributor;

 

 

of Class A shares of a Fund initially purchased by an employee benefit plan;

 

 

other than Class A shares, of a Fund initially purchased by an employee benefit plan that are not connected with a plan level termination;

 

 

in connection with the Fund’s Small Account Policy (which is described below in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies);

 

 

at a Fund’s discretion, issued in connection with plans of reorganization, including but not limited to mergers, asset acquisitions and exchange offers, to which the Fund is a party; and

 

 

by certain other investors as set forth in more detail in the Merger SAI.

CDSC — Waivers of the CDSC for Class B shares. The CDSC will be waived on redemptions of shares:

 

B-25


Table of Contents

 

 

in the event of the shareholder’s death;

 

 

that result from required minimum distributions taken from retirement accounts upon the shareholder’s attainment of age 70 1/2;

 

 

in connection with the Fund’s Small Account Policy (which is described below in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies); and

 

 

by certain other investors, including certain institutions as set forth in more detail in the Merger SAI.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases.

Please see the Merger SAI for more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here.

Repurchases

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a redemption of any Class A, B, C or T shares of the Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the redemption proceeds. Any CDSC paid upon redemption of your Class A, B, C or T shares of the Fund will not be reimbursed. If your original purchase was in Class T shares, you will be allowed to reinvest in the same Class T shares account and Fund you originally purchased.

Legacy RiverSource fund shareholders may not invest or reinstate their investment in Class B shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund. However, shareholders who redeem Class B shares of the Fund and wish to reinvest all or a portion of the redemption proceeds within 90 days of redemption can invest in Class A shares without incurring a front-end sales charge. To qualify, shareholders must notify their selling and/or servicing agent or the Transfer Agent in writing in advance of reinvestment and must purchase shares into an account with the same account owner information.

To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges, the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request from you or your selling and/or servicing agent within 90 days after the shares are redeemed and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order. The repurchased shares will be deemed to have the original purchase date for purposes of applying the CDSC (if any) to subsequent redemptions. Systematic withdrawals and purchases are excluded from this policy.

Distribution and Service Fees

Pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, the applicable Board has approved, and the Funds have adopted, distribution and/or shareholder service plans which set the distribution and/or service fees that are periodically deducted from the Fund assets. These fees are calculated daily, may vary by share class and are intended to compensate the Distributor and/or eligible selling and/or servicing agents for selling shares of the Fund and providing services to investors. Because the fees are paid out of the Fund’s assets on an ongoing basis, they will increase the cost of your investment over time.

 

B-26


Table of Contents

 

The table below shows the maximum annual distribution and/or service fees (as an annual % of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees applicable to each share class:

 

    

Distribution Fee

  

Service Fee

  

Combined Total

Class A

   up to 0.25%    up to 0.25%    up to  0.35%(a)(b)(c)

Class B

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%(a)(b)

Class C

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%(d)

Class E

   0.10%    0.25%    0.35%

Class F

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%

Class I

   none    none    None

Class R (Legacy Columbia funds)

   0.50%    (e)    0.50%

Class R (Legacy RiverSource funds)

   up to 0.50%    up to 0.25%    0.50%(e)

Class R3

   0.25%    0.25%(f)    0.50%(f)

Class R4

   none    0.25%(f)    0.25%(f)

Class R5

   none    None    none

Class T

   none    0.50%(g)    0.50%(g)

Class W

   up to 0.25%    up to 0.25%    0.25%(c)

Class Y

   none    none    none

Class Z

   none    none    none

 

(a) As shown in the table below, the maximum distribution and service fees of Class A shares varies among the Funds, as follows:

 

B-27


Table of Contents

 

Funds

  

Maximum
Class A
Distribution
Fee

  

Maximum
Class A
Service Fee

  

Maximum
Class A
Combined Total

Legacy RiverSource funds (other than Columbia Money Market Fund)    Up to 0.25%    Up to 0.25%    0.25%
Columbia Money Market Fund          0.10%
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund, Columbia Balanced Fund, Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund, Columbia Contrarian Core Fund, Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, Columbia Dividend Income Fund, Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund, Columbia Small Cap Core Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I, Columbia Technology Fund    up to 0.10%    up to 0.25%    up to 0.35%; these Funds may pay distribution and service fees up to a maximum of 0.35% of the their average daily net assets attributable to Class A shares (comprised of up to 0.10% for distribution services and up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services) but currently limit such fees to an aggregate fee of not more than 0.25% for Class A shares.
Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Bond Fund, Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Core Bond Fund, Columbia Corporate Income Fund, Columbia Emerging Markets Fund, Columbia Federal Securities Fund, Columbia Greater China Fund, Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund, Columbia Liberty Fund, Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Columbia International Bond Fund, Columbia International Growth Fund, Columbia International Stock Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund, Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Select Small Cap Fund, Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Strategic Income Fund, Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund, Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund, Columbia World Equity Fund       0.25%    0.25%
Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund, Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Tax Exempt Fund       0.20%    0.20%

 

B-28


Table of Contents

Funds

  

Maximum
Class A
Distribution
Fee

  

Maximum
Class A
Service Fee

  

Maximum
Class A
Combined Total

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II, Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Convertible Securities Fund, Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Global Value Fund, Columbia High Income Fund, Columbia International Value Fund, Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Columbia Marsico Global Fund, Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Short Term Bond Fund, Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Total Return Bond Fund, Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Large Cap Value Fund, Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund, Columbia Marsico Growth Fund, Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio, Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II, Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund, Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Columbia Small Cap Index Fund, Columbia Overseas Value Fund          0.25%; these Funds pay a combined distribution and service fee pursuant to their combined distribution and shareholder servicing plan for Class A shares.

 

(b)

The service fees for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of certain Funds depend on when the shares were purchased, as described below.

Service Fee for Class A shares and Class B shares of Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund and Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.10% on net assets attributable to shares of these Funds issued prior to December 1, 1994 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to Fund shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.10% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2009, the blended service fee was 0.24% of the Fund’s average net assets for each of these Funds, other than Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund, which had a blended service fee of 0.23%.

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Columbia Liberty Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.15% on net assets attributable to shares of this Fund issued prior to April 1, 1989 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for all shares that is a blend between the 0.15% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2009, the blended service fee was 0.24% of the Fund’s average daily net assets.

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Columbia Strategic Income Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.15% on net assets attributable to shares of this Fund issued prior to January 1, 1993 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for all Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.15% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended May 31, 2010, the blended service fee was 0.25% of the Fund’s average net assets.

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund, Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.20% of the average daily net asset value of all shares of such Fund class.

Distribution Fee for Class B shares and Class C shares for Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund – The annual distribution fee shall be 0.65% of the average daily net assets of the Fund’s Class B shares and Class C shares. Fee amounts noted apply to Class B shares of the Funds other than Class B shares of Columbia Money Market Fund, which pay distribution fees of up to 0.75% and service fees of up to 0.10%, for a combined total of 0.85%.

(c)

Fee amounts noted apply to all Funds other than Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly RiverSource Cash Management Fund), which, for each of Class A and Class W shares, pays distribution and service fees of 0.10%, and for Class C shares pays distribution fees of 0.75%. The Distributor has voluntarily agreed, effective April 15, 2010, to waive the 12b-1 fees it receives from Class A, Class C, Class R (formerly Class R2) and

 

B-29


Table of Contents
 

Class W shares of Columbia Money Market Fund and from Class A, Class C and Class R (formerly Class R2) shares of Columbia Government Money Market Fund. Compensation paid to broker-dealers and other financial intermediaries may be suspended to the extent of the Distributor’s waiver of the 12b-1 fees on these specific share classes of these Funds.

(d)

The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares of the following Funds so that the combined distribution and service fee (or the distribution fee for Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund and Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund) does not exceed the specified percentage annually: 0.40% for Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund; 0.45% for Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund and Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund; 0.56% for Columbia Short Term Bond Fund; 0.65% for Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund; 0.80% for Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund and Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund; 0.85% for Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund, Columbia Core Bond Fund, Columbia Corporate Income Fund, Columbia Federal Securities Fund, Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund, Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund, Columbia Strategic Income Fund and Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund. These arrangements may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

(e)

Class R shares of Legacy Columbia funds pay a distribution fee pursuant to a distribution (Rule 12b-1) plan for Class R shares. The Legacy Columbia funds do not have a shareholder service plan for Class R shares. The Legacy RiverSource funds have a distribution and shareholder service plan for Class R shares, which, prior to the close of business on September 3, 2010, were known as Class R2 shares. For Legacy RiverSource fund Class R shares, the maximum fee under the plan reimbursed for distribution expenses is equal on an annual basis to 0.50% of the average daily net assets of the Fund attributable to Class R shares. Of that amount, up to 0.25% may be reimbursed for shareholder service expenses.

(f)

The shareholder service fees for Class R3 and Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a plan administration services agreement, the Funds’ Class R3 and Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

(g)

The shareholder servicing fees for Class T shares are up to 0.50% of average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for equity Funds (including Columbia Asset Allocation Fund) and 0.40% for fixed income Funds. The Funds currently limit such fees to a maximum of 0.30% for equity Funds and 0.15% for fixed-income Funds other than Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, for which the limit currently is 0.00%. See Class T Shareholder Service Fees below for more information.

The distribution and/or shareholder service fees for Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class R and Class W shares, as applicable, are subject to the requirements of Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, and are used by the Distributor to make payments, or to reimburse the Distributor for certain expenses it incurs, in connection with distributing the Fund’s shares and directly or indirectly providing services to Fund shareholders. These payments or expenses include providing distribution and/or shareholder service fees to selling and/or servicing agents that sell shares of the Fund or provide services to Fund shareholders. The Distributor may retain these fees otherwise payable to selling and/or servicing agents if the amounts due are below an amount determined by the Distributor in its discretion.

For Legacy RiverSource fund Class A, Class B and Class W shares, the Distributor begins to pay these fees immediately after purchase. For Legacy RiverSource fund Class C shares, the Distributor pays these fees in advance for the first 12 months. Selling and/or servicing agents also receive distribution fees up to 0.75% of the average daily net assets of Legacy RiverSource fund Class C shares sold and held through them, which the Distributor begins to pay 12 months after purchase. For Legacy RiverSource fund Class B shares, and, for the first 12 months following the sale of Legacy RiverSource fund Class C shares, the Distributor retains the distribution fee of up to 0.75% in order to finance the payment of sales commissions to selling and/or servicing agents, and to pay for other distribution related expenses. Selling and/or servicing agents may compensate their financial advisors with the shareholder service and distribution fees paid to them by the Distributor.

For Legacy Columbia fund Class E, Class R shares and, with the exception noted in the next sentence, Class A shares, the Distributor begins to pay these fees immediately after purchase. For Legacy Columbia fund Class B, Class F, Class A (if purchased as part of a purchase of shares of $1 million or more) and, with the exception noted in the next sentence, Class C shares, the Distributor begins to pay these fees 12 months after purchase (for Columbia fund Class B and Class F shares, and, for the first 12 months following the sale of Columbia Class C shares, the Distributor retains the distribution fee of up to 0.75% in order to finance the payment of sales commissions to selling and/or servicing agents, and to pay for other distribution related expenses). For Legacy Columbia fund Class C shares, selling and/or servicing agents may opt to decline payment of sales commission and, instead, may receive these fees immediately after purchase. Selling and/or servicing agents may compensate their financial advisors with the shareholder service and distribution fees paid to them by the Distributor.

If you maintain shares of the Fund directly with the Fund, without working directly with a financial advisor or selling and/or servicing agent, distribution and service fees may be retained by the Distributor as payment or reimbursement for incurring certain distribution and shareholder service related expenses.

 

B-30


Table of Contents

 

Over time, these distribution and/or shareholder service fees will reduce the return on your investment and may cost you more than paying other types of sales charges. The Fund will pay these fees to the Distributor and/or to eligible selling and/or servicing agents for as long as the distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans continue in effect. The Fund may reduce or discontinue payments at any time. Your selling and/or servicing agent may also charge you other additional fees for providing services to your account, which may be different from those described here.

Class T Shareholder Service Fees

The Funds that offer Class T shares have adopted a shareholder servicing plan that permits them to pay for certain services provided to Class T shareholders by their selling and/or servicing agents. Equity Funds (including Columbia Asset Allocation Fund) may pay shareholder servicing fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.50% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.25% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.30% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services. Fixed income Funds may pay shareholder service fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.40% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of an annual rate of up to 0.20% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.20% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.15% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services, other than Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, for which the limit currently is 0.00%.

Class R3 and Class R4 Shares Plan Administration Fee

Class R3 and Class R4 shares pay an annual plan administration services fee for the provision of various administrative, recordkeeping, communication and educational services. The fee for Class R3 and Class R4 shares is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of average daily net assets attributable to the class.

Selling and/or Servicing Agent Compensation

The Distributor and the investment manager make payments, from their own resources, to selling and/or servicing agents, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for marketing/sales support services relating to the Funds. Such payments are generally based upon one or more of the following factors: average net assets of the Funds sold by the Distributor attributable to that intermediary, gross sales of the Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that intermediary, reimbursement of ticket charges (fees that a selling and/or servicing agent charges its representatives for effecting transactions in Fund shares) or a negotiated lump sum payment. While the financial arrangements may vary for each intermediary, the support payments to any one intermediary are generally between 0.05% and 0.50% on an annual basis for payments based on average net assets of the Fund attributable to the intermediary, and between 0.05% and 0.25% on an annual basis for firms receiving a payment based on gross sales of the Funds attributable to the intermediary.

The Distributor and the investment manager may make payments in larger amounts or on a basis other than those described above when dealing with certain selling and/or servicing agents, including certain affiliates of Bank of America Corporation (Bank of America). Such increased payments may enable such selling and/or servicing agents to offset credits that they may provide to customers.

The Distributor, the Transfer Agent and the investment manager may also make payments to financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, that provide shareholder services to retirement plans and other investment programs to compensate those selling and/or servicing agents for services they provide to such programs, including, but not limited to, sub-accounting, sub-transfer agency, similar shareholder or participant recordkeeping, shareholder or participant reporting, or shareholder or participant transaction processing.

These payments for shareholder servicing support vary by selling and/or servicing agent but generally are not expected, with certain limited exceptions, to exceed 0.40% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares in any intermediary’s program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that pay a service fee pursuant to a plan under Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, and 0.45% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares in any intermediary’s program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that do not pay a service fee pursuant to a plan under Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act.

 

B-31


Table of Contents

 

For all classes other than Class Y shares, the Funds may reimburse the Transfer Agent for amounts paid to selling and/or servicing agents that maintain assets in omnibus accounts, subject to an annual cap that varies among Funds. Generally, the annual cap for each Fund (other than the Columbia Acorn funds) is 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in each such account for selling and/or servicing agents that seek payment by the Transfer Agent based on a percentage of net assets. Please see the Merger SAI for additional information. The annual cap for Columbia Acorn funds is 0.05% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in such accounts. The amounts in excess of that reimbursed by the Fund are borne by the Distributor or the investment manager. The Distributor and the investment manager may make other payments or allow promotional incentives to broker/dealers to the extent permitted by SEC and Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA) rules and by other applicable laws and regulations.

Amounts paid by the Distributor and the investment manager and their affiliates are paid out of the Distributor’s and the investment manager’s own resources and do not increase the amount paid by you or the Fund. You can find further details in the Merger SAI about the payments made by the Distributor and the investment manager and their affiliates, as well as a list of the selling and/or servicing agents, including Ameriprise Financial affiliates, to which the Distributor and the investment manager have agreed to make marketing support payments. Your selling and/or servicing agent may charge you fees and commissions in addition to those described herein. You should consult with your selling and/or servicing agent and review carefully any disclosure your selling and/or servicing agent provides regarding its services and compensation. Depending on the financial arrangement in place at any particular time, a selling and/or servicing agent and its financial advisors may have a financial incentive for recommending the Fund or a particular share class over others.

 

B-32


Table of Contents

 

Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares

Share Price Determination

The price you pay or receive when you buy, sell or exchange shares is the Fund’s next determined net asset value (or NAV) per share for a given share class. The Fund calculates the net asset value per share for each class of the Fund at the end of each business day.

FUNDamentalsTM

NAV Calculation

Each of the Fund’s share classes calculates its NAV per share as follows:

 

(Value of assets of the share class)

NAV =  – (Liabilities of the share class)

Number of outstanding shares of the class

 

 

FUNDamentalsTM

Business Days

A business day is any day that the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) is open. A business day ends at the close of regular trading on the NYSE, usually at 4:00 p.m. Eastern time. If the NYSE closes early, the business day ends as of the time the NYSE closes. On holidays and other days when the NYSE is closed, the Fund’s net asset value is not calculated and the Fund does not accept buy or sell orders. However, the value of the Fund’s assets may still change on days that the NYSE is closed, including to the extent that the Fund holds foreign securities that trade on days that foreign securities markets are open.

The value of the Fund’s shares is based on the total market value of all of the securities and other assets that it holds as of a specified time. The prices reported on stock exchanges and other securities markets around the world are usually used to value securities in the Fund. The Fund uses the amortized cost method, which approximates market value, to value short-term investments maturing in 60 days or less. For a Fund organized as a fund-of-funds, the assets will consist primarily of shares of the underlying funds, which are valued at their NAVs.

If a market price isn’t readily available, the Fund will determine the price of the security held by the Fund based on the investment manager’s determination of the security’s fair value. A market price is considered not readily available if, among other circumstances, the most recent reported price is deemed unreliable. In addition, the Fund may use fair valuation to price securities that trade on a foreign exchange when a significant event has occurred after the foreign exchange closes but before the time at which the Fund’s share price is calculated. Foreign exchanges typically close before the time at which Fund share prices are calculated, and may be closed altogether on some days when the Fund is open. Such significant events affecting a foreign security may include, but are not limited to: (1) those impacting a single issuer; (2) governmental action that affects securities in one sector or country; (3) natural disasters or armed conflicts affecting a country or region; or (4) significant domestic or foreign market fluctuations. The Fund uses various criteria, including an evaluation of U.S. market moves after the close of foreign markets, in determining whether a security’s market price is readily available and, if not, the fair value of the security.

Fair valuation may have the effect of reducing stale pricing arbitrage opportunities presented by the pricing of Fund shares. However, when the Fund uses fair valuation to price securities, it may value those securities higher or lower than another fund would have priced the security. Also, the use of fair valuation may cause the Fund’s performance to

 

B-33


Table of Contents

diverge to a greater degree from the performance of various benchmarks used to compare the Fund’s performance because benchmarks generally do not use fair valuation techniques. Because of the judgment involved in fair valuation decisions, there can be no assurance that the value ascribed to a particular security is accurate. The Fund has retained one or more independent fair valuation pricing services to assist in the fair valuation process for foreign securities. International markets are sometimes open on days when U.S. markets are closed, which means that the value of foreign securities owned by the Fund could change on days when Fund shares cannot be bought or sold.

For money market Funds, the Fund’s investments are valued at amortized cost, which approximates market value.

Transaction Rules and Policies

Remember that sales charges may apply to your transactions. You should also ask your selling and/or servicing agent about its rules, fees and policies for buying, selling and exchanging shares, which may be different from those described here, and about its related programs or services.

Also remember that the Fund may refuse any order to buy or exchange shares. If this happens, the Fund will return any money it received, but no interest will be paid on that money.

Order Processing

Orders to buy, sell or exchange Fund shares are processed on business days. Depending upon the class of shares, orders can be delivered by mail, by telephone or online. Orders received in “good form” by the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent before the end of a business day are priced at the Fund’s net asset value per share on that day. Orders received after the end of a business day will receive the next business day’s net asset value per share. The market value of the Fund’s investments may change between the time you submit your order and the time the Fund next calculates its net asset value per share. The business day that applies to your order is also called the trade date.

“Good Form”

An order is in “good form” if the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent has all of the information and documentation it deems necessary to effect your order. For example, when you sell shares by letter of instruction, “good form” means that your letter has (i) complete instructions and the signatures of all account owners, (ii) a Medallion Signature Guarantee (as described below) for amounts greater than $100,000 and (iii) any other required documents completed and attached. For the documents required for sales by corporations, agents, fiduciaries, surviving joint owners and other legal entities, call 800.345.6611.

Medallion Signature Guarantees

A Medallion Signature Guarantee helps assure that a signature is genuine and not a forgery. The selling and/or servicing agent providing the Medallion Signature Guarantee is financially liable for the transaction if the signature is a forgery.

Qualified customers can obtain a Medallion Signature Guarantee from any financial institution – including commercial banks, credit unions and broker/dealers – that participates in one of the three Medallion Signature Guarantee programs recognized by the Securities and Exchange Commission. These Medallion Signature Guarantee programs are the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program (STAMP), the Stock Exchanges Medallion Program (SEMP) and the New York Stock Exchange Medallion Signature Program (MSP). Please note that a guarantee from a notary public is not acceptable.

A Medallion Signature Guarantee is required if:

 

 

The amount is greater than $100,000.

 

 

You want your check made payable to someone other than the registered account owner(s).

 

 

Your address of record has changed within the last 30 days.

 

 

You want the check mailed to an address other than the address of record.

 

 

You want the proceeds sent to a bank account not on file.

 

 

You are the beneficiary of the account and the account owner is deceased (additional documents may be required).

 

B-34


Table of Contents

 

Written Transactions

Once you have an account, you can communicate written buy, sell and exchange orders to the Transfer Agent at The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp at the following address (regular mail) P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 and (express mail) 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809.

Telephone Transactions

For Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shareholders, once you have an account, you may place orders to buy, sell or exchange shares by telephone. To place orders by telephone, call 800.422.3737. Have your account number and social security number (SSN) or taxpayer identification number (TIN) available when calling.

You can sell up to and including an aggregate of $100,000 of shares via the telephone per day, per Fund, if you qualify for telephone orders. Wire redemptions requested via the telephone are subject to a maximum of $3 million of shares per day, per Fund. You can buy up to and including $100,000 of shares per day, per Fund through your bank account as an Automated Clearing House (ACH) transaction via the telephone if you qualify for telephone orders.

Telephone orders may not be as secure as written orders. The Funds will take reasonable steps to confirm that telephone instructions are genuine. For example, we require proof of your identification before we will act on instructions received by telephone and may record telephone conversations. However, the Fund and its agents will not be responsible for any losses, costs or expenses resulting from an unauthorized telephone instruction when reasonable steps have been taken to confirm that telephone instructions are genuine. Telephone orders may be difficult to complete during periods of significant economic or market change or business interruption.

Online Transactions

Once Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shareholders have an account, they may contact the Transfer Agent at 800.345.6611 for more information on account trading restrictions and the special sign-up procedures required for online transactions. The Transfer Agent has procedures in place to authenticate electronic orders you deliver through the internet. You will be required to accept the terms of an online agreement and to establish and utilize a password in order to access online account services.

You can sell up to and including an aggregate of $100,000 of shares per day, per Fund account through the internet if you qualify for internet orders.

Customer Identification Program

U.S. Federal law requires the Fund to obtain and record specific personal information to verify your identity when you open an account. This information may include your name, address, date of birth (for individuals) and taxpayer or other government issued identification (e.g., SSN or TIN). If you fail to provide the requested information, the Fund may need to delay the date of your purchase or may be unable to open your account, which may result in a return of your investment monies. In addition, if the Fund is unable to verify your identity after your account is open, the Fund reserves the right to close your account or take other steps as deemed reasonable. The Fund will not be liable for any loss resulting from any purchase delay, application rejection or account closure due to a failure to provide proper identifying information.

Small Account Policy – Class A, B, C, T and Z Share Accounts Below $250

The Funds generally will automatically sell your shares if the value of your Fund account (treating each account of the Fund you own separately from any other account of the Fund you may own) falls below $250. If your shares are sold, the Transfer Agent will remit the sale proceeds to you. Any otherwise applicable CDSC will not be imposed on such an automatic sale of your shares. The Transfer Agent will send you written notification in advance of any automatic sale, which will provide details on how you may avoid such an automatic sale. Generally, you may avoid such an automatic sale by raising your account balance, consolidating your accounts through an exchange of shares of another Fund in which you hold shares, or setting up a Systematic Investment Plan. For more information, contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. The Transfer Agent’s contact information (toll-free number and mailing address) as well as the Funds’ website address can be found at the beginning of the section Choosing a Share Class.

The Fund may also sell your Fund shares if your selling and/or servicing agent tells us to sell your shares pursuant to arrangements made with you, and under certain other circumstances allowed under the 1940 Act.

 

B-35


Table of Contents

 

Small Account Policy – Class A, B, C, T and Z Share Accounts Minimum Balance Fee

If the value of your Fund account (treating each account of the Fund you own separately from any other account of the Fund you may own) falls below the minimum initial investment requirement applicable to you for any reason, including as a result of market decline, your account generally will be subject to a $20 annual fee. This fee will be assessed through the automatic sale of Fund shares in your account. Any otherwise applicable CDSC will not be imposed on such an automatic sale of your shares. The Transfer Agent will reduce the expenses paid by the Fund by any amounts it collects from the assessment of this fee. For Funds that do not have transfer agency expenses against which to offset the amount collected through assessment of this fee, the fee will be paid directly to the Fund. The Transfer Agent will send you written notification in advance of assessing any fee, which will provide details on how you can avoid the imposition of such fee. Generally, you may avoid the imposition of such fee by raising your Fund account balance, consolidating your Fund accounts through an exchange of shares of another Fund in which you hold shares, or setting up a Systematic Investment Plan. For more information, contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. The Transfer Agent’s contact information (toll-free number and mailing address) as well as the Funds’ website address can be found at the beginning of the section Choosing a Share Class.

Each Fund reserves the right to change its minimum investment requirements. The Funds also reserve the right to lower the account size trigger point for the minimum balance fee in any year or for any class of shares when we believe it is appropriate to do so in light of declines in the market value of Fund shares, sales loads applicable to a particular class of shares, or for other reasons.

Exceptions to the Small Account Policy (Accounts Below $250 and Minimum Balance Fee)

The automatic sale of Fund shares of accounts under $250 and the annual minimum balance fee described above do not apply to shareholders of Class E, Class F, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class Y or Class W shares; shareholders holding their shares through broker/dealer networked accounts; wrap fee and omnibus accounts; accounts with active Systematic Investment Plans; certain qualified retirement plans; and health savings accounts. The automatic sale of Fund shares of accounts under $250 does not apply to individual retirement plans.

Small Account Policy – Broker/Dealer and Wrap Fee Accounts

The Funds may automatically redeem at any time broker/dealer networked accounts and wrap fee accounts that have account balances of $20 or less or have less than one share.

Cash Flows

The timing and magnitude of cash inflows from investors buying Fund shares could prevent the Fund from always being fully invested. Conversely, the timing and magnitude of cash outflows to investors redeeming Fund shares could require large ready reserves of uninvested cash to meet shareholder redemptions. Either situation could adversely impact the Fund’s performance.

Information Sharing Agreements

As required by Rule 22c-2 under the 1940 Act, the Funds or certain of their service providers will enter into information sharing agreements with selling and/or servicing agents, including participating life insurance companies and financial intermediaries that sponsor or offer retirement plans through which shares of the Funds are made available for purchase. Pursuant to Rule 22c-2, selling and/or servicing agents are required, upon request, to: (i) provide shareholder account and transaction information and (ii) execute instructions from the Fund to restrict or prohibit further purchases of Fund shares by shareholders who have been identified by the Fund as having engaged in transactions that violate the Fund’s excessive trading policies and procedures. See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Excessive Trading Practices for more information.

Excessive Trading Practices Policy of Non-Money Market Funds

Right to Reject or Restrict Share Transaction Orders — The Fund is intended for investors with long-term investment purposes and is not intended as a vehicle for frequent trading activity (market timing) that is excessive. Investors should transact in Fund shares primarily for investment purposes. The Board has adopted excessive trading policies and procedures that are designed to deter excessive trading by investors (the Excessive Trading Policies and Procedures). The Fund discourages and does not accommodate excessive trading.

 

B-36


Table of Contents

 

The Fund reserves the right to reject, without any prior notice, any buy or exchange order for any reason, and will not be liable for any loss resulting from rejected orders. For example, the Fund may in its discretion restrict or reject a buy or exchange order even if the transaction is not subject to the specific exchange limitation described below if the Fund or its agents determine that accepting the order could interfere with efficient management of the Fund’s portfolio or is otherwise contrary to the Fund’s best interests. The Excessive Trading Policies and Procedures apply equally to buy or exchange transactions communicated directly to the Transfer Agent and to those received by selling and/or servicing agents.

Specific Buying and Exchanging Limitations — If a Fund detects that an investor has made two “material round trips” in any 28-day period, it will generally reject the investor’s future buy orders, including exchange buy orders, involving any Fund.

For these purposes, a “round trip” is a purchase or exchange into the Fund followed by a sale or exchange out of the Fund, or a sale or exchange out of the Fund followed by a purchase or exchange into the Fund. A “material” round trip is one that is deemed by the Fund to be material in terms of its amount or its potential detrimental impact on the Fund. Independent of this limit, the Fund may, in its discretion, reject future buy orders by any person, group or account that appears to have engaged in any type of excessive trading activity.

These limits generally do not apply to automated transactions or transactions by registered investment companies that invest in the Fund using a “fund-of-funds” structure. These limits do not apply to payroll deduction contributions by retirement plan participants, transactions initiated by a retirement plan sponsor or certain other retirement plan transactions consisting of rollover transactions, loan repayments and disbursements, and required minimum distribution redemptions. They may be modified or rescinded for accounts held by certain retirement plans to conform to plan limits, for considerations relating to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or regulations of the Department of Labor, and for certain asset allocation or wrap programs. Accounts known to be under common ownership or control generally will be counted together, but accounts maintained or managed by a common intermediary generally will not be considered to be under common ownership or control. The Fund retains the right to modify these restrictions at any time without prior notice to shareholders.

Limitations on the Ability to Detect and Prevent Excessive Trading Practices — The Fund takes various steps designed to detect and prevent excessive trading, including daily review of available shareholder transaction information. However, the Fund receives buy, sell and exchange orders through selling and/or servicing agents, and cannot always know of or reasonably detect excessive trading that may be facilitated by selling and/or servicing agents or by the use of the omnibus account arrangements they offer. Omnibus account arrangements are common forms of holding shares of mutual funds, particularly among certain selling and/or servicing agents such as broker/dealers, retirement plans and variable insurance products. These arrangements often permit selling and/or servicing agents to aggregate their clients’ transactions and accounts, and in these circumstances, the identity of the shareholders is often not known to the Fund.

Some selling and/or servicing agents apply their own restrictions or policies to underlying investor accounts, which may be more or less restrictive than those described here. This may impact the Fund’s ability to curtail excessive trading, even where it is identified. For these and other reasons, it is possible that excessive trading may occur despite the Fund’s efforts to detect and prevent it.

Although these restrictions and policies involve judgments that are inherently subjective and may involve some selectivity in their application, the Fund seeks to act in a manner that it believes is consistent with the best interests of shareholders in making any such judgments.

Risks of Excessive Trading — Excessive trading creates certain risks to the Fund’s long-term shareholders and may create the following adverse effects:

 

 

negative impact on the Fund’s performance;

 

 

potential dilution of the value of the Fund’s shares;

 

 

interference with the efficient management of the Fund’s portfolio, such as the need to maintain undesirably large cash positions, the need to use its line of credit or the need to buy or sell securities it otherwise would not have bought or sold;

 

 

losses on the sale of investments resulting from the need to sell securities at less favorable prices;

 

 

increased taxable gains to the Fund’s remaining shareholders resulting from the need to sell securities to meet sell orders; and

 

 

increased brokerage and administrative costs.

 

B-37


Table of Contents

 

To the extent that the Fund invests significantly in foreign securities traded on markets that close before the Fund’s valuation time, it may be particularly susceptible to dilution as a result of excessive trading. Because events may occur after the close of foreign markets and before the Fund’s valuation time that influence the value of foreign securities, investors may seek to trade Fund shares in an effort to benefit from their understanding of the value of foreign securities as of the Fund’s valuation time. This is often referred to as price arbitrage. The Fund has adopted procedures designed to adjust closing market prices of foreign securities under certain circumstances to reflect what the Fund believes to be the fair value of those securities as of its valuation time. To the extent the adjustments don’t work fully, investors engaging in price arbitrage may cause dilution in the value of the Fund’s shares held by other shareholders.

Similarly, to the extent that the Fund invests significantly in thinly traded high-yield bonds (junk bonds) or equity securities of small-capitalization companies, because these securities are often traded infrequently, investors may seek to trade their shares in an effort to benefit from their understanding of the value of these securities. This is also a type of price arbitrage. Any such frequent trading strategies may interfere with efficient management of the Fund’s portfolio to a greater degree than would be the case for mutual funds that invest in highly liquid securities, in part because the Fund may have difficulty selling those portfolio securities at advantageous times or prices to satisfy large and/or frequent sell orders. Any successful price arbitrage may also cause dilution in the value of Fund shares held by other shareholders.

Excessive Trading Practices Policy of Money Market Funds

The money market Funds are designed to offer investors a liquid cash option that they may buy and sell as often as they wish. Accordingly, the Board has not adopted policies and procedures designed to discourage excessive or short-term trading of money market Fund shares. However, since frequent purchases and sales of money market Fund shares could in certain instances harm shareholders in various ways, including reducing the returns to long-term shareholders by increasing costs (such as spreads paid to dealers who trade money market instruments with the money market Funds) and disrupting portfolio management strategies, each of the money market Funds reserves the right, but has no obligation, to reject any purchase or exchange transaction at any time. Except as expressly described herein (such as minimum purchase amounts), the money market Funds have no limits on buy or exchange transactions. In addition, each of the money market Funds reserve the right to impose or modify restrictions on purchases, exchanges or trading of the Fund shares at any time.

Opening an Account and Placing Orders

We encourage you to consult with a financial advisor who can help you with your investment decisions and who can help you open an account. Once you have an account, you can buy, sell and exchange shares by contacting your financial advisor who will send your order to the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. As described in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies, once you have an account you can also communicate your orders directly to the Transfer Agent by mail, by telephone or online.

The Funds are available directly and through broker-dealers, banks and other selling and/or servicing agents or institutions, and through certain qualified and non-qualified plans, wrap fee products or other investment products sponsored by selling and/or servicing agents.

Not all selling and/or servicing agents offer the Funds and certain selling and/or servicing agents that offer the Funds may not offer all Funds on all investment platforms. Please consult with your financial advisor to determine the availability of the Funds. If you set up an account at a selling and/or servicing agent that does not have, and is unable to obtain, a selling agreement with the Distributor, you will not be able to transfer Fund holdings to that account. In that event, you must either maintain your Fund holdings with your current selling and/or servicing agent, find another selling and/or servicing agent with a selling agreement, or sell your Fund shares, paying any applicable CDSC. Please be aware that transactions in taxable accounts are taxable events and may result in income tax liability.

Selling and/or servicing agents that offer the Funds may charge you additional fees for the services they provide and they may have different policies not described herein. Some policy differences may include different minimum investment amounts, exchange privileges, Fund choices and cutoff times for investments. Additionally, recordkeeping, transaction processing and payments of distributions relating to your account may be performed by the selling and/or servicing agents through which your shares of the Fund are held. Since the Fund (and its service providers) may not have a record of your account transactions, you should always contact the financial advisor employed by the selling and/or servicing agent through which you purchased or at which you maintain your shares of the Fund to make changes to your account or to give instructions concerning

 

B-38


Table of Contents

your account, or to obtain information about your account. The Fund and its service providers, including the Distributor and the Transfer Agent, are not responsible for the failure of one of these financial intermediaries and/or its selling and/or servicing agents to carry out its obligations to its customers.

As stated above, you may establish and maintain your account with a selling and/or servicing agent authorized by the Distributor to sell fund shares or directly with the Fund. The Fund may engage selling and/or servicing agents to receive purchase orders and exchange (and sale) orders on its behalf. Accounts established directly with the Fund will be serviced by the Transfer Agent. The Funds, the Transfer Agent and the Distributor do not provide investment advice. The Funds encourage you to consult with a financial advisor who can help you with your investment decisions and who can help you open an account. Once you have an account, you can buy, sell and exchange shares by contacting your financial advisor who will send your order to the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent. As described in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies, once you have an account you can also communicate your orders directly to the Transfer Agent.

Accounts established directly with the Fund

You or the financial advisor through which you buy shares may establish an account with the Fund. To do so, complete a Fund account application with your financial advisor or investment professional, and mail the account application to the address below. Account applications may be obtained at columbiamanagement.com or may be requested by calling 800.345.6611. Make your check payable to the Fund. You will be assessed a $15 fee for any checks rejected by your financial institution due to insufficient funds or other reasons. The Funds do not accept cash, credit card convenience checks, money orders, traveler’s checks, starter checks, third or fourth party checks, or other cash equivalents.

Mail your check and completed application to The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (regular mail) P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 or (express mail) 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809. You may also use these addresses to request an exchange or redemption of Fund shares.

You will be sent a statement confirming your purchase and any subsequent transactions in your account. You will also be sent quarterly and annual statements detailing your transactions in the Fund and the other Funds you own under the same account number. Duplicate quarterly account statements for the current year and duplicate annual statements for the most recent prior calendar year will be sent to you free of charge. Copies of year-end statements for prior years are available for a fee. Please contact the Transfer Agent for more information.

Buying Shares

Eligible Investors

Class A and Class C Shares

Class A and Class C shares are available to the general public for investment. Once you have opened an account, you can buy Class A and Class C shares in a lump sum, through our Systematic Investment Plan, by dividend diversification, by wire or by electronic funds transfer. For money market Funds, new investments must be made in Class A, Class I (available as a new investment only to the Funds (i.e., Fund-of-Fund investment)), Class T, Class W or Class Z shares of the Fund, subject to eligibility. Class C and Class R of the money market Funds are available as a new investment only to investors in the Distributor’s proprietary 401(k) products, provided that such investor is eligible to invest in the Class and transacts directly with the Fund or the Transfer Agent through a third party administrator or third party recordkeeper. The money market Funds offer other classes of shares only to facilitate exchanges with other Funds offering these classes of shares.

Class B Shares Closed

The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions involving existing investors in Class B shares as described in more detail below.

Additional Class B shares will be issued only to existing investors in Class B shares and only through the following two types of transactions (Qualifying Transactions):

 

 

Dividends and/or capital gain distributions may continue to be reinvested in Class B shares of a Fund.

 

B-39


Table of Contents

 

 

Shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Fund may exchange those shares for Class B shares of other Funds offering such shares. Certain exceptions apply, including that not all Funds may permit exchanges.

Any initial purchase orders for the Fund’s Class B shares will be rejected (other than through a Qualifying Transaction that is an exchange transaction).

Unless contrary instructions are received in advance by the Fund, any purchase orders (except those submitted by a selling and/or servicing agent through the National Securities Clearing Corporation (NSCC) as described in more detail below) that are initial investments in Class B shares or that are orders for additional Class B shares of the Fund received from existing investors in Class B shares, including orders made through an active systematic investment plan, will automatically be invested in Class A shares of the Fund, without regard to the normal minimum initial investment requirement for Class A shares, but subject to the front-end sales charge that generally applies to Class A shares. For additional information about Class A shares, see Choosing a Share Class – Class A Shares – Front-end Sales Charges. Your selling and/or servicing agent may have different policies not described here, including a policy to reject purchase orders for a Fund’s Class B shares or to automatically invest the purchase amount in a money market fund. Please consult your selling and/or servicing agent to understand their policy.

Additional purchase orders for a Fund’s Class B shares by an existing Class B shareholder, submitted by such shareholder’s selling and/or servicing agent through the NSCC, will be rejected due to operational limitations of the NSCC. Investors should consult their selling and/or servicing agent if they wish to invest in the Fund by purchasing a share class of the Fund other than Class B shares.

Dividend and/or capital gain distributions from Class B shares of a Fund will not be automatically invested in Class B shares of another Fund. Unless contrary instructions are received in advance of the date of declaration, such dividend and/or capital gain distributions from Class B shares of a Fund will be reinvested in Class B shares of the same Fund that is making the distribution.

Class E and Class F Shares Closed

Class E and Class F shares are closed to new investors and new accounts. Shareholders who opened and funded an account with the Fund as of September 22, 2006 (including accounts once funded that subsequently reached a zero balance) (i) may continue to make additional purchases of Class E and Class F shares and (ii) will continue to have their dividend and capital gains distributions reinvested. These share classes are designed for investors who wish to make an irrevocable gift to a child, grandchild or other individual. Shares are held in an irrevocable trust until a specified date, at which time they pass to a beneficiary.

Class I Shares

Class I shares are currently only available to the Funds (i.e., Fund of Fund investments). Class I shares may be purchased, sold or exchanged only through the Distributor or an authorized selling and/or servicing agent. The Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments in Class I shares from other institutional investors.

Class R Shares

Class R shares can only be bought through eligible health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Ameriprise Financial affiliates, and the following eligible retirement plans: 401(k) plans; 457 plans; employer-sponsored 403(b) plans; profit sharing and money purchase pension plans; defined benefit plans; and non-qualified deferred compensation plans. Class R shares are not available for investment through retail nonretirement accounts, traditional and Roth IRAs, Coverdell Education Savings Accounts, SEPs, SAR-SEPs, Simple IRAs, individual 403(b) plans or 529 tuition programs. Contact the Transfer Agent or your retirement plan or health savings account administrator for more information about investing in Class R shares. The Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments in Class R shares from other institutional investors.

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 Shares

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are closed to new investors and new accounts effective as of the close of business on December 31, 2010, subject to certain limited exceptions described below.

 

B-40


Table of Contents

 

Shareholders who opened and funded a Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 account with the Fund as of the close of business on December 31, 2010 (including accounts once funded that subsequently reached a zero balance) may continue to make additional purchases of these share classes. Plans may continue to make additional purchases of Fund shares and add new participants, and new plans sponsored by the same or an affiliated sponsor may invest in the Fund (and add new participants) if an initial plan so sponsored invested in the Fund as of December 31, 2010 (or has approved the Fund as an investment option as of December 31, 2010 and funds its initial account with the Fund prior to March 31, 2011) and holds Fund shares at the plan level.

In the event that an order to purchase Class R3, Class R4 or Class R5 shares is received by the Fund or the Transfer Agent after the close of business on December 31, 2010 (other than as described above) from a new investor or a new account that is not eligible to purchase shares, that order will be refused by the Fund and the Transfer Agent and any money that the Fund or the Transfer Agent received with the order will be returned to the investor or the selling and/or servicing agent, as appropriate, without interest.

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are designed for qualified employee benefit plans, trust companies or similar institutions, charitable organizations that meet the definition in Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code, non-qualified deferred compensation plans whose participants are included in a qualified employee benefit plan described above, state sponsored college savings plans established under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code, and health savings accounts created pursuant to public law 108-173. Additionally, if approved by the Distributor, Class R5 shares are available to institutional or corporate accounts above a threshold established by the Distributor (currently $1 million per Fund or $10 million in all Funds) and bank trust departments. Class R3, Class R4 and R5 shares may be purchased, sold or exchanged only through the Distributor or an authorized selling and/or servicing agent. Class R3, Class R4 shares and Class R5 shares of the Fund may be exchanged for Class R3 shares, Class R4 shares and Class R5 shares, respectively, of another Fund.

Class T Shares Closed

Class T shares are available for purchase only to investors who received (and who have continuously held) Class T shares in connection with the merger of certain Galaxy funds into various Columbia funds (formerly named Liberty funds).

Class W Shares

Class W shares are available to investors purchasing through authorized investment programs managed by investment professionals, including discretionary managed account programs. Class W shares may be purchased, sold or exchanged only through the Distributor or an authorized selling and/or servicing agent. Shares originally purchased in a discretionary managed account may continue to be held in Class W outside of a discretionary managed account, but no additional Class W purchases may be made and no exchanges to Class W shares of another Fund may be made outside of a discretionary managed account. The Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments in Class W shares from other institutional investors.

Class Y Shares

Class Y shares are available only to the following categories of eligible investors:

 

 

Individual investors and institutional clients (endowments, foundations, defined benefit plans, etc.) who invest at least $1 million in Class Y shares of a single Fund; and

 

 

Group retirement plans (including 401(k) plans, 457 plans, employer-sponsored 403(b) plans, profit sharing and money purchase plans) with plan assets of at least $10 million.

Currently, Class Y shares are offered only to certain former shareholders of the series of the former Columbia Funds Institutional Trust and to institutional and high net worth individuals and clients invested in certain pooled investment vehicles and separate accounts managed by the investment manager.

Class Z Shares

Class Z shares are available only to the categories of eligible investors described below under “Minimum Investment and Account Balance — Class Z Shares Minimum Investments”

In addition, for Class I, Class R, Class W, Class Y and Class Z shares, the Distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments from other institutional investors not listed above.

 

B-41


Table of Contents

 

Minimum Initial Investments, Additional Investments and Account Balances

The table below shows the Fund’s minimum initial investment, additional investment and minimum account balance requirements, which may vary by Fund, class and type of account.

 

Minimum Investment and Account Balance

     Minimum
Initial investment
  Minimum
Additional investments
   Minimum
Account balance

For all Funds, classes and accounts except those listed below

(non-qualified)

   $2,000(a)   $100    $250(d)

Individual Retirement Accounts

   $1,000   $100    none

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund,

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund,

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

   $10,000   $100    $5,000

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund,

Columbia Floating Rate Fund,

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

   $5,000   $100    $2,500

Class I, Class R

   none   none    none

Class W

   $500   none    $500

Class Y

   variable(b)   $100    $250

Class Z

   variable(a)(c)   $100    $250(d)

 

(a)

If your Class A, B, C, T or Z shares account balance falls below the minimum initial investment amount for any reason, including a market decline, you may be asked to increase it to the minimum initial investment amount or establish a systematic investment plan. If you do not do so, it will be subject to a $20 annual low balance fee and/or shares may be automatically redeemed and the proceeds mailed to you if the account falls below the minimum account balance requirement.

(b)

The minimum initial investment amount for Class Y shares varies depending on eligibility. For eligibility details, see Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Buying Shares — Eligible Investors — Class Y Shares.

(c)

The minimum initial investment requirement for Class Z shares is $0, $1,000 or $2,000 depending upon the category of eligible investor. For details, see Class Z Shares Minimum Investments below.

(d)

If the value of your account falls below $250, your Fund account is subject to automatic redemption of Fund shares. For details, see Small Account Policy above.

Systematic Investment Plan

The Systematic Investment Plan allows you to make regular purchases via automatic transfers from your bank account to the Fund on a monthly, quarterly or semi-annual basis. Contact the Transfer Agent or your financial advisor to set up the plan. The table below shows the minimum initial investments, minimum additional investments and minimum account balance for investment through a Systematic Investment Plan:

 

B-42


Table of Contents

 

Minimum Investment and Account Balance — Systematic Investment Plans

     Minimum
Initial investment
  Minimum
Additional investments
   Minimum
Account balance*

For all Funds, classes and accounts except those listed below

(non-qualified)

   $100*(a)   $100    none*(b)

Individual Retirement Accounts

   $100*(b)   $50    none

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund,

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund,

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

   $10,000   $100    $5,000

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund,

Columbia Floating Rate Fund,

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

   $5,000   $100    $2,500

Class I, Class R

   none   none    none

Class W

   $500   none    $500

Class Y

   variable(c)   $100    none

Class Z

   variable(d)   $100   

 

none*  If your Fund account balance is below the minimum initial investment requirement described in this table, you must make investments at least monthly, as follows:
(a)

money market Funds — $2,000; and

(b)

money market Funds — $1,000.

(c)

The minimum initial investment amount for Class Y shares varies depending on eligibility. For eligibility details, see Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares — Buying Shares — Eligible Investors — Class Y Shares.

(d)

The minimum initial investment requirement for Class Z shares is $0, $1,000 or $2,000 depending upon the category of eligible investor. For details, see Class Z Shares Minimum Investments below.

Class Z Shares Minimum Investments

There is no minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following categories of eligible investors:

 

 

Any person investing all or part of the proceeds of a distribution, rollover or transfer of assets into a Columbia Management Individual Retirement Account, from any deferred compensation plan which was a shareholder of any of the Funds of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000, in which the investor was a participant and through which the investor invested in one or more of the Funds of Columbia Acorn Trust immediately prior to the distribution, transfer or rollover.

 

B-43


Table of Contents

 

 

Any health savings account sponsored by a third party platform and any omnibus group retirement plan for which a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity provides services and is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than in the form of payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent.

 

 

Any investor participating in a wrap program sponsored by a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity that is paid an asset-based fee by the investor and that is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent.

The minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following eligible investors is $1,000:

 

 

Any individual retirement plan (assuming the eligibility criteria below are met) or group retirement plan that is not held in an omnibus manner for which a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity provides services and is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than in the form of payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent.

 

 

Any person employed as of April 30, 2010 by the former investment manager, distributor or transfer agent of the Legacy Columbia funds is eligible to make new and subsequent purchases in the Class Z shares through an individual retirement account.

The minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following categories of eligible investors is $2,000:

 

 

Any investor buying shares through a Columbia Management state tuition plan organized under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code.

 

 

Any shareholder (as well as any family member of a shareholder or person listed on an account registration for any account of the shareholder) of another fund distributed by the Distributor (i) who holds Class Z shares; (ii) who held Primary A shares prior to the share class redesignation of Primary A shares as Class Z shares that occurred on August 22, 2005; (iii) who holds Class A shares that were obtained by an exchange of Class Z shares; or (iv) who bought shares of certain mutual funds that were not subject to sales charges and that merged with a Legacy Columbia fund distributed by the Distributor.

 

 

Any trustee or director (or family member of a trustee or director) of a fund distributed by the Distributor.

 

 

Any investor participating in an account offered by a selling and/or servicing agent or other entity that provides services to such an account, is paid an asset-based fee by the investor and is not compensated by the Fund for those services, other than payments for shareholder servicing or sub-accounting performed in place of the Transfer Agent (each investor buying shares through a selling and/or servicing agent must independently satisfy the minimum investment requirement noted above).

 

 

Any institutional investor who is a corporation, partnership, trust, foundation, endowment, institution, government entity, or similar organization, which meets the respective qualifications for an accredited investor, as defined under the Securities Act of 1933.

 

 

Certain financial institutions and intermediaries, such as insurance companies, trust companies, banks, endowments, investment companies or foundations, buying shares for their own account, including Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates and/or subsidiaries.

 

 

Any person employed as of April 30, 2010 by the former investment manager, distributor or transfer agent of the Legacy Columbia funds is eligible to make new and subsequent purchases in the Class Z shares through a non-retirement account.

 

 

Certain other investors as set forth in more detail in the Merger SAI.

The minimum initial investment requirements may be waived for accounts that are managed by an investment professional, for accounts held in approved discretionary or non-discretionary wrap programs, for accounts that are a part of an employer-sponsored retirement plan, or for other account types if approved by the Distributor.

The Fund reserves the right to modify its minimum investment and related requirements at any time, with or without prior notice.

Dividend Diversification

Generally, you may automatically invest distributions made by another Fund into the same class of shares (and in some cases certain other classes of shares) of the Fund at no additional sales charge. A sales charge may apply when you invest distributions made with respect to shares that were not subject to a sales charge at the time of your initial purchase. Call the Funds at 800.345.6611 for details. See Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares — Opening an Account and Placing Orders — Buying Shares — Class B Shares Closed for restrictions applicable to Class B shares.

 

B-44


Table of Contents

 

Wire Purchases

You may buy Class A, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shares of the Fund by wiring money from your bank account to your Fund account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.345.6611.

Electronic Funds Transfer

You may buy Class A, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shares of the Fund by electronically transferring money from your bank account to your Fund account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. An electronic funds transfer may take up to three business days to settle and be considered in “good form.” You must set up this feature by contacting the Transfer Agent prior to your request to obtain any necessary forms. The minimum investment amount for additional purchases via electronic funds transfer is $100.

Important: Payments sent by electronic fund transfers, a bank authorization, or check that are not guaranteed may take up to 10 or more days to clear. If you request a redemption before the purchase funds clear, this may cause your redemption request to fail to process if the requested amount includes unguaranteed funds. If you purchased your shares by check or from your bank account as an Automated Clearing House (ACH) transaction, the Fund holds the redemption proceeds when you sell those shares for a period of time after the trade date of the purchase.

Other Purchase Rules You Should Know

 

 

Once the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your buy order in “good form,” your purchase will be made at the next calculated public offering price per share, which is the net asset value per share plus any sales charge that applies.

 

 

You generally buy Class A, Class E and Class T shares at the public offering price per share because purchases of these share classes are generally subject to a front-end sales charge.

 

 

You buy Class B, Class C, Class F, Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class W, Class Y and Class Z shares at net asset value per share because no front-end sales charge applies to purchases of these share classes.

 

 

The Fund reserves the right to cancel your order if it doesn’t receive payment within three business days of receiving your buy order. The Fund will return any payment received for orders that have been cancelled, but no interest will be paid on that money.

 

 

Selling and/or servicing agents are responsible for sending your buy orders to the Transfer Agent and ensuring that we receive your money on time.

 

 

Shares bought are recorded on the books of the Fund. The Fund doesn’t issue certificates.

Selling Shares

When you sell your shares, the Fund is effectively buying them back from you. This is called a redemption. You may sell your shares at any time. The payment will be sent within seven days after your request is received in good order. When you sell shares, the amount you receive may be more or less than the amount you invested. Your sale price will be the next NAV calculated after your request is received in good order, minus any applicable CDSC.

Remember that Class R, R3, R4 and R5 shares are sold through your eligible retirement plan or health savings account. For detailed rules regarding the sale of these classes of shares, contact the Transfer Agent, your retirement plan or health savings account administrator.

Wire Redemptions

You may request that your Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class I, Class T, Class W, Class Y and Class Z share sale proceeds be wired to your bank account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. You must set up this feature prior to your request. The Transfer Agent charges a fee for shares sold by Fedwire. The Transfer Agent may waive the fee for certain accounts. The receiving bank may charge an additional fee. The minimum amount that can be redeemed by wire is $500.

 

B-45


Table of Contents

 

Electronic Funds Transfer

You may sell Class A, Class B, Class C, Class E, Class F, Class T, Class Y and Class Z shares of the Fund and request that the proceeds be electronically transferred to your bank account by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. It may take up to three business days for the sale proceeds to be received by your bank. You must set up this feature by contacting the Transfer Agent prior to your request to obtain any necessary forms.

Systematic Withdrawal Plan

The Systematic Withdrawal Plan lets you withdraw funds from your Class A, Class B, Class C, Class I, Class T, Class W, Class Y and/or Class Z shares account any day of the month on a monthly, quarterly or semi-annual basis. Contact the Transfer Agent or your financial advisor to set up the plan. To set up the plan, your account balance must meet the Fund Class’ minimum initial investment amount. All dividend and capital gain distributions must be reinvested to set up the plan. A Systematic Withdrawal Plan cannot be set up on an account that already has a Systematic Investment Plan established. If you set up the plan after you’ve opened your account, we may require your signature to be Medallion Signature Guaranteed.

You can choose to receive your withdrawals via check or direct deposit into your bank account. Otherwise, the Fund will deduct any applicable CDSC from the withdrawals before sending the balance to you. You can cancel the plan by giving the Fund 30 days notice in writing or by calling the Transfer Agent at 800.422.3737. It’s important to remember that if you withdraw more than your investment in the Fund is earning, you’ll eventually use up your original investment.

Check Redemption Service

Class A shares of the money market Funds offer check writing privileges. If you have $2,000 in a money market Fund, you may request checks which may be drawn against your account. The amount of any check drawn against your money market Fund must be at least $100. You can elect this service on your initial application or thereafter. Call 800.345.6611 for the appropriate forms to establish this service. If you own Class A shares that were both in another Fund at NAV because of the size of the purchase, and then exchanged into a money market Fund, check redemptions may be subject to a CDSC. A $15 charge will be assessed for any stop payment order requested by you or any overdraft in connection with checks written against your money market Fund account.

In-Kind Distributions

The Fund reserves the right to honor sell orders with in-kind distributions of portfolio securities instead of cash. In the event the Fund makes such an in-kind distribution, you may incur the brokerage and transaction costs associated with converting the portfolio securities you receive into cash. Also, the portfolio securities you receive may increase or decrease in value before you convert them into cash.

Other Redemption Rules You Should Know

 

 

Once the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your sell order in “good form,” your shares will be sold at the next calculated net asset value per share. Any applicable CDSC will be deducted from the amount you’re selling and the balance will be remitted to you.

 

 

If you sell your shares directly through the Funds, we will normally send the sale proceeds by mail or electronically transfer them to your bank account within three business days after the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your order in “good form.”

 

 

If you sell your shares through a selling and/or servicing agent, the Funds will normally send the sale proceeds by Fedwire within three business days after the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent receives your order in “good form.”

 

 

If you paid for your shares by check or from your bank account as an Automated Clearing House (ACH) transaction, the Funds will hold the sale proceeds when you sell those shares for a period of time after the trade date of the purchase.

 

 

No interest will be paid on uncashed redemption checks.

 

 

The Funds can delay payment of the redemption proceeds for up to seven days and may suspend redemptions and/or further postpone payment of redemption proceeds when the NYSE is closed or during emergency circumstances as determined by the SEC.

 

B-46


Table of Contents

 

 

Other restrictions may apply to retirement accounts. For information about these restrictions, contact your retirement plan administrator.

 

 

Also keep in mind the Funds’ Small Account Policy, which is described above in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares — Transaction Rules and Policies.

 

 

For Class E shareholders, if, at the time of the trust’s termination, the beneficiary does not elect to redeem Class E shares held by the trust, the shares automatically will convert to Class A shares of the Fund and be registered in the beneficiary’s name. For Class F shareholders, if, at the time of the trust’s termination, the beneficiary does not elect to redeem Class F shares held by the trust, the shares automatically will convert to Class B shares of the Fund and be registered in the beneficiary’s name. After such conversion, the beneficiary’s shares no longer will convert to Class E shares, but will convert to Class A shares in accordance with the applicable conversion schedule for Class B shares. Automatic conversion of Class B shares to Class A shares occurs eight years after purchase for these shares. For purposes of calculating the conversion period, the beneficiary ownership period for the Class B shares will begin at the time the Class F shares were purchased.

 

 

For Class E and Class F shareholders, if the beneficiary under a Columbia Advantage Plan trust exercises his or her withdrawal rights, the financial advisor may be required to refund to the Distributor any sales charge or initial commission previously retained or paid on the withdrawn Class E and/or Class F shares or amount redeemed.

Exchanging Shares

You can generally sell shares of a Fund to buy shares of another Fund, in what is called an exchange. You should read the prospectus of, and make sure you understand the investment objective, principal investment strategies, risks, fees and expenses of, the Fund into which you are exchanging. You may be subject to a sales charge if you exchange from a money market Fund or any other Fund that does not charge a front-end sales charge into a non–money market Fund. If you hold your Fund shares through certain selling and/or servicing agents, including Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., you may have limited exchangeability among the Funds. Please contact your financial advisor for more information.

Systematic Exchanges

You may buy Class A, Class C, Class T, Class W, Class Y and/or Class Z shares of a Fund by exchanging each month from another Fund for shares of the same class of the Fund at no additional cost, subject to the following exchange amount minimums: $50 each month for individual retirement accounts (i.e. tax qualified accounts); and $100 each month for non-retirement accounts. Contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent to set up the plan. If you set up your plan to exchange more than $100,000 each month, you must obtain a Medallion Signature Guarantee.

Exchanges will continue as long as your balance is sufficient to complete the systematic monthly transfers, subject to the Funds’ Small Account Policy described above in Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares – Transaction Rules and Policies. You may terminate the program or change the amount you would like to exchange (subject to the $50 and $100 minimum requirements noted immediately above) by calling the Funds at 800.345.6611. A sales charge may apply when you exchange shares of a Fund that were not assessed a sales charge at the time of your initial purchase.

The rules described below for making exchanges apply to systematic exchanges.

Other Exchange Rules You Should Know

 

 

Exchanges are made at net asset value next calculated after your exchange order is received in good form.

 

 

Once the Fund receives your exchange request, you cannot cancel it after the market closes.

 

 

The rules for buying shares of a Fund generally apply to exchanges into that Fund, including, if your exchange creates a new Fund account, it must satisfy the minimum investment amount, unless a waiver applies.

 

 

Shares of the purchased Fund may not be used on the same day for another exchange or sale.

 

 

You can generally make exchanges between like share classes of any Fund. Some exceptions apply.

 

B-47


Table of Contents

 

 

If you exchange shares from Class A shares of a money market Fund to a non-money market Fund, any further exchanges must be between shares of the same class. For example, if you exchange from Class A shares of a money market Fund into Class C shares of a non-money market Fund, you may not exchange from Class C shares of that non-money market Fund back to Class A shares of a money market Fund.

 

 

A sales charge may apply when you exchange shares of a Fund that were not assessed a sales charge at the time of your initial purchase. If your initial investment was in a money market Fund and you exchange into a non-money market Fund, your transaction is subject to a front-end sales charge if you exchange into Class A shares and to a CDSC if you exchange into Class C, Class E, Class F and Class T shares of the Funds.

 

 

If your initial investment was in Class A shares of a non-money market Fund and you exchange shares into a money market Fund, you may exchange that amount to another Fund, including dividends earned on that amount, without paying a sales charge.

 

 

If your shares are subject to a CDSC, you will not be charged a CDSC upon the exchange of those shares. Any CDSC will be deducted when you sell the shares you received from the exchange. The CDSC imposed at that time will be based on the period that begins when you bought shares of the original Fund and ends when you sell the shares of the Fund you received from the exchange. The applicable CDSC will be the CDSC of the original Fund.

 

 

Class T shares may be exchanged for Class T or Class A shares. Class T shares exchanged into Class A shares cannot be exchanged back into Class T shares.

 

 

Class Z shares of a Fund may be exchanged for Class A or Class Z shares of another Fund.

 

 

You may make exchanges only into a Fund that is legally offered and sold in your state of residence. Contact the Transfer Agent or your selling and/or servicing agent for more information.

 

 

You generally may make an exchange only into a Fund that is accepting investments.

 

 

The Fund may change or cancel your right to make an exchange by giving the amount of notice required by regulatory authorities (generally 60 days for a material change or cancellation).

 

 

Unless your account is part of a tax-advantaged arrangement, an exchange for shares of another Fund is a taxable event, and you may recognize a gain or loss for tax purposes.

 

 

Shares of Class W originally purchased, but no longer held in a discretionary managed account, may not be exchanged for Class W shares of another Fund. You may continue to hold these shares in the original Fund. Changing your investment to a different Fund will be treated as a sale and purchase, and you will be subject to applicable taxes on the sale and sales charges on the purchase of the new Fund.

You may exchange or sell shares by having your selling and/or servicing agent process your transaction. If you maintain your account directly with your selling and/or servicing agent, you must contact that agent to exchange or sell shares of the Fund. If your account was established directly with the Fund, there are a variety of methods you may use to exchange or sell shares of the Fund.

Same-Fund Exchange Privilege for Class Z Shares

Certain shareholders invested in a class of shares other than Class Z may become eligible to invest in Class Z shares. Upon a determination of such eligibility, any such shareholders will be eligible to exchange their shares for Class Z shares of the same Fund, if offered. No sales charges or other charges will apply to any such exchange, except that when Class B shares are exchanged for Class Z shares, any CDSC charges applicable to Class B shares will be applied. Ordinarily, shareholders will not recognize a gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon such an exchange. Investors should contact their selling and/or servicing agents to learn more about the details of the Class Z shares exchange privilege.

Ways to Request a Sale or Exchange of Shares

Account established with your selling and/or servicing agent

You can exchange or sell Fund shares by having your financial advisor or selling and/or servicing agent process your transaction. They may have different policies not described herein, including different transaction limits, exchange policies and sale procedures.

 

B-48


Table of Contents

 

Mail your sale or exchange request to The Funds, c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (regular mail) P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081 or (express mail) 30 Dan Road, Canton, MA 02021-2809.

Include in your letter: your name; the name of the Fund(s); your account number; the class of shares to be exchanged or sold; your social security number (SSN) or taxpayer identification number (TIN); the dollar amount or number of shares you want to exchange or sell; specific instructions regarding delivery or exchange destination; signature(s) of registered account owner(s); and any special documents the Transfer Agent may require in order to process your order.

Corporate, trust or partnership accounts may need to send additional documents. Payment will be mailed to the address of record and made payable to the names listed on the account, unless your request specifies differently and is signed by all owners.

Distributions and Taxes

Distributions to Shareholders

A mutual fund can make money two ways:

 

 

It can earn income on its investments. Examples of fund income are interest paid on money market instruments and bonds, and dividends paid on common stocks.

 

 

A mutual fund can also have capital gains if the value of its investments increases. While a fund continues to hold an investment, any gain is unrealized. If the fund sells an investment, it generally will realize a capital gain if it sells that investment for a higher price than it originally paid. Capital gains are either short-term or long-term, depending on whether the fund holds the securities for one year or less (short-term gains) or more than one year (long-term gains).

FUNDamentalsTM

Distributions

Mutual funds make payments of fund earnings to shareholders, distributing them among all shareholders of the fund. As a shareholder, you are entitled to your portion of a fund’s distributed income, including capital gains.

Reinvesting your distributions buys you more shares of a fund – which lets you take advantage of the potential for compound growth. Putting the money you earn back into your investment means it, in turn, may earn even more money. Over time, the power of compounding has the potential to significantly increase the value of your investment. There is no assurance, however, that you’ll earn more money if you reinvest your distributions rather than receive them in cash.

The Fund intends to pay out, in the form of distributions to shareholders, a sufficient amount of its income and gains so that the Fund will qualify for treatment as a regulated investment company and generally will not have to pay any federal excise tax. The Fund generally intends to distribute any net realized capital gain (whether long-term or short-term gain) at least once a year.

Different share classes of the Fund usually pay different net investment income distribution amounts, because each class has different expenses. Each time a distribution is made, the net asset value per share of the share class is reduced by the amount of the distribution.

The Fund generally pays cash distributions within five business days after the distribution was declared (or, if the Fund declares distributions daily, within five business days after the end of the month in which the distribution was declared). If you sell all of your shares after the record date, but before the payment date, for a distribution, you’ll normally receive that distribution in cash within five business days after the sale was made.

The Fund will automatically reinvest distributions in additional shares of the same share class of the Fund unless you inform us you want to receive your distributions in cash (the financial selling and/or servicing agent through which you purchased shares may have different policies). You can do this by writing the Funds at the addresses and telephone numbers listed at the beginning of the section entitled Choosing a Share Class. No sales charges apply to the purchase or sale of such shares.

For accounts held directly with the Fund, distributions of $10 or less will automatically be reinvested in additional Fund shares only. If you elect to receive distributions by check and the check is returned as undeliverable, all subsequent distributions will be reinvested in additional shares of the Fund.

 

B-49


Table of Contents

 

Unless you are a tax-exempt investor or holding Fund shares through a tax-advantaged account (such as a 401(k) plan or IRA), you should consider avoiding buying Fund shares shortly before the Fund makes a distribution (other than distributions of net investment income that are declared daily) of net investment income or net realized capital gain, because doing so can cost you money in taxes. This is because you will, in effect, receive part of your purchase price back in the distribution. This is known as “buying a dividend.” To avoid “buying a dividend,” before you invest, check the Fund’s distribution schedule, which is available at the Funds’ websites and/or by calling the Funds’ telephone numbers listed at the beginning of the section entitled Choosing a Share Class.

If you buy shares of the Fund when it holds securities with unrealized capital gain, you may, in effect, receive part of your purchase price back if and when the Fund sells those securities and distributes any net realized gain. Any such distribution is generally subject to tax. The Fund may have, or may build up over time, high levels of unrealized capital gain. If you buy shares of the Fund when it has capital loss carryforwards, the Fund may have the ability to offset capital gains realized by the Fund that otherwise would have been distributed to shareholders with such carryforwards, although capital loss carryforwards generally expire after eight taxable years and may be subject to substantial limitations.

Taxes and Your Investment

The Fund will send you a statement each year showing how much you’ve received in distributions in the prior year and the distributions’ character for U.S. federal income tax purposes. In addition, you should be aware of the following considerations applicable to all Funds (unless otherwise noted):

 

 

The Fund intends to qualify each year as a regulated investment company. A regulated investment company generally is not subject to tax at the fund level on income and gains from investments that are distributed to shareholders. However, the Fund’s failure to qualify as a regulated investment company would result in Fund level taxation, and consequently, a reduction in income available for distribution to you. In addition, any dividends of net tax-exempt income would no longer be exempt from U.S. federal income tax and, instead, in general, would be taxable to you as ordinary income.

 

 

Distributions generally are taxable to you when paid, whether they are paid in cash or automatically reinvested in additional shares of the Fund.

 

 

Certain derivative instruments when held in a Fund’s portfolio subject the Fund to special tax rules, the effect of which may be to accelerate income to the Fund, defer fund losses, cause adjustments in the holding periods of Fund portfolio securities, convert capital gains into ordinary income and convert short-term capital losses into long-term capital losses. These rules could therefore affect the amount, timing and/or character of distributions to shareholders. For tax-exempt Funds: Derivative instruments held by a Fund may also generate taxable income to the Fund.

 

 

Certain Funds may purchase or sell (write) options, as described further in the Merger SAI. In general, option premiums which may be received by the Fund are not immediately included in the income of the Fund. Instead, such premiums are taken into account when the option contract expires, the option is exercised by the holder, or the Fund transfers or otherwise terminates the option. If an option written by a Fund is exercised and such Fund sells or delivers the underlying security, the Fund generally will recognize capital gain or loss equal to (a) the sum of the exercise price and the option premium received by the Fund minus (b) the Fund’s basis in the security. Such gain or loss generally will be short-term or long-term depending upon the holding period of the underlying security. Gain or loss with respect to any termination of a Fund’s obligation under an option other than through the exercise of the option and the related sale or delivery of the underlying security generally will be short-term gain or loss. Thus, for example, if an option written by a Fund expires unexercised, such Fund generally will recognize short-term gain equal to the premium received.

 

 

For tax-exempt Funds: Tax-exempt Funds expect that distributions will consist primarily of exempt-interest dividends. Distributions of the Fund’s net interest income from tax-exempt securities generally are not subject to U.S. federal income tax, but may be subject to state and local income and other taxes, as well as federal and state alternative minimum tax. Similarly, distributions of interest income that is exempt from state and local income taxes of a particular state generally will be exempt from such taxes, but may be subject to other taxes, including income taxes of other states, and federal and state alternative minimum tax.

 

 

For tax-exempt Funds: The Fund may invest a portion of its assets in securities that generate income that is not exempt from federal or state income tax. Distributions by the Fund of this income generally are taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions of gains realized by the Fund, including those generated from the sale or exchange of tax-exempt securities, generally also are taxable to you. Distributions of the Fund’s net short-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions of the Fund’s net long-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as long-term capital gain. Whether capital gains are long-term or short-term is determined by how long the Fund has owned the investments that generated them, rather than how long you have owned your shares.

 

B-50


Table of Contents

 

 

Distributions of the Fund’s ordinary income and net short-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions of the Fund’s net long-term capital gain, if any, generally are taxable to you as long-term capital gain. Whether capital gains are long-term or short-term is determined by how long the Fund has owned the investments that generated them, rather than how long you have owned your shares.

 

 

For taxable fixed income Funds: Taxable fixed-income Funds expect that distributions will consist primarily of ordinary income.

 

 

For taxable years beginning on or before December 31, 2010, if you are an individual and you meet certain holding period and other requirements for your Fund shares, a portion of your distributions may be treated as “qualified dividend income” taxable at lower net long-term capital gain rates. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision to taxable years beginning after December 31, 2010. Qualified dividend income is income attributable to the Fund’s dividends received from certain U.S. and foreign corporations, as long as the Fund meets certain holding period and other requirements for the stock producing such dividends. For taxable fixed income Funds and tax-exempt Funds: Taxable fixed income Funds and tax-exempt Funds do not expect a significant portion of Fund distributions to be derived from qualified dividend income.

 

 

For taxable years beginning on or before December 31, 2010, the maximum individual U.S. federal income tax rate on net long-term capital gain (and thus qualified dividend income) has been temporarily reduced to 15%. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this rate reduction to taxable years beginning after December 31, 2010.

 

 

A sale, redemption or exchange of Fund shares is a taxable event. This includes redemptions where you are paid in securities. Your sales, redemptions and exchanges of Fund shares (including those paid in securities) usually will result in a taxable capital gain or loss to you, equal to the difference between the amount you receive for your shares (or are deemed to have received in the case of exchanges) and the amount you paid (or are deemed to have paid in the case of exchanges) for them. Any such capital gain or loss generally will be long-term capital gain or loss if you have held your Fund shares for more than one year at the time of sale or exchange. In certain circumstances, capital losses may be converted from short-term to long-term or disallowed.

 

 

The Fund is required by federal law to withhold tax on any taxable and possibly tax-exempt distributions and redemption proceeds paid to you (including amounts paid to you in securities and amounts deemed to be paid to you upon an exchange of shares) if: you haven’t provided a correct TIN or SSN or haven’t certified to the Fund that withholding doesn’t apply; the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) has notified us that the TIN listed on your account is incorrect according to its records; or the IRS informs the Fund that you are otherwise subject to backup withholding.

 

 

Class E and Class F shareholders, under the Columbia Gift Plan, the trustee will file all federal and state income tax returns and pay all related income taxes for income and capital gains earned prior to the trust’s termination. Under the Columbia Advantage Plan, the beneficiary will be obligated to report any income and capital gains earned by the trust on his or her own tax returns and to pay any related income taxes.

 

 

Class E and Class F shareholders, you should consult with your own tax advisor about the particular tax consequences to you of making a gift and holding Fund shares through a trust, including any applicable federal or state estate or gift tax consequences.

 

 

If at the end of the taxable year more than 50% of the value of the Fund’s assets consists of securities of foreign corporations, and the Fund makes a special election, you will generally be required to include in income your share of the foreign taxes paid by the Fund. You may be able to either deduct this amount from your income or claim it as a foreign tax credit. There is no assurance that the Fund will make a special election for a taxable year, even if it is eligible to do so.

For a Fund organized as a fund-of-funds. Because most of the Fund’s investments are shares of underlying Funds, the tax treatment of the Fund’s gains, losses, and distributions may differ from the tax treatment that would apply if either the Fund invested directly in the types of securities held by the underlying Funds or the Fund shareholders invested directly in the underlying funds. As a result, you may receive taxable distributions earlier and recognize higher amounts of capital gain or ordinary income than you otherwise would.

FUNDamentalsTM

Taxes

The information provided above is only a summary of how U.S. federal income taxes may affect your investment in the Fund. It is not intended as a substitute for careful tax planning. Your investment in the Fund may have other tax implications. It does not apply to certain types of investors who may be subject to special rules, including foreign or tax-

 

B-51


Table of Contents

exempt investors or those holding Fund shares through a tax-advantaged account, such as a 401(k) plan or IRA. You should consult with your own tax advisor about the particular tax consequences to you of an investment in the Fund, including the effect of any foreign, state and local taxes, and the effect of possible changes in applicable tax laws.

ADDITIONAL SERVICES AND COMPENSATION

In addition to acting as the Fund’s investment manager, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (Columbia Management) and its affiliates also receive compensation for providing other services to the Funds.

Administration Services. Ameriprise Financial, Inc., 200 Ameriprise Financial Center, Minneapolis, MN 55474, provides or compensates others to provide administrative services to the Legacy RiverSource funds, which includes the Seligman and Threadneedle branded funds. These services include administrative, accounting, treasury, and other services.

Distribution and Shareholder Services. Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.), One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, provides underwriting and distribution services to the Funds.

Transfer Agency Services. Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly RiverSource Service Corporation), One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, provides or compensates others to provide transfer agency services to the Funds. The Funds pay the Transfer Agent a fee that may vary by class, as set forth in the Merger SAI, and reimburses the transfer agent for its out-of-pocket expenses incurred while providing these transfer agency services to the Funds. The Transfer Agent pays a portion of these fees to selling and servicing agents that provide sub-recordkeeping and other services to Fund shareholders. The Merger SAI provides additional information about the services provided and the fee schedules for the Transfer Agent agreements.

ADDITIONAL MANAGEMENT INFORMATION

Affiliated Products. Columbia Management serves as investment manager to the Funds, including those that are structured to provide asset-allocation services to shareholders of those Funds (funds of funds) by investing in shares of other Funds (collectively referred to as underlying funds) and to discretionary managed accounts (collectively referred to as affiliated products) that invest exclusively in underlying funds. These affiliated products, individually or collectively, may own a significant percentage of the outstanding shares of the underlying funds, and Columbia Management seeks to balance potential conflicts between the affiliated products and the underlying funds in which they invest. The affiliated products investment in the underlying funds may also have the effect of creating economies of scale (including lower expense ratios) because the affiliated products may own substantial portions of the shares of underlying funds and, comparatively, a redemption of underlying fund shares by one or more affiliated products could cause the expense ratio of an underlying fund to increase as its fixed costs would be spread over a smaller asset base. Because of these large positions of the affiliated products, the underlying funds may experience relatively large purchases or redemptions. Although Columbia Management may seek to minimize the impact of these transactions, for example, by structuring them over a reasonable period of time or through other measures, underlying funds may experience increased expenses as they buy and sell securities to manage these transactions. When Columbia Management structures transactions over a reasonable period of time in order to manage the potential impact of the buy and sell decisions for the affiliated products, these affiliated products, including funds of funds, may pay more or less for shares of the underlying funds than if the transactions were executed in one transaction. In addition, substantial redemptions by the affiliated products within a short period of time could require the underlying fund to liquidate positions more rapidly than would otherwise be desirable, which may have the effect of reducing or eliminating potential gain or causing the underlying fund to realize a loss. Substantial redemptions may also adversely affect the ability of the investment manager to implement the underlying fund’s investment strategy. Columbia Management also has an economic conflict of interest in determining the allocation of the affiliated products’ assets among the underlying funds as it earns different fees from the underlying funds. Columbia Management monitors expense levels of the Funds and is committed to offering funds that are competitively priced. Columbia Management reports to the Board of each fund of funds on the steps it has taken to manage any potential conflicts. See the Merger SAI for information on the percent of the Fund owned by affiliated products.

Cash Reserves. A Fund may invest its daily cash balance in a money market fund selected by Columbia Management, including but not limited to RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund (Short-Term Cash Fund), a money market Fund established for the exclusive use of the Funds and other institutional clients of Columbia Management. While Short-Term Cash Fund does not pay an advisory fee to Columbia Management, it does incur other expenses. A Fund will invest in Short-Term Cash Fund or any other money market fund selected by Columbia Management only to the extent it is consistent with the Fund’s investment objectives and policies. Short-Term Cash Fund is not insured or guaranteed by the FDIC or any other government agency.

 

B-52


Table of Contents

 

Fund Holdings Disclosure. The Board has adopted policies and procedures that govern the timing and circumstances of disclosure to shareholders and third parties of information regarding the securities owned by a Fund. A description of these policies and procedures is included in the Merger SAI.

The website references herein are intended to be inactive textual references and information contained in or otherwise accessible through the referenced websites does not form a part of this combined proxy statement/prospectus.

 

B-53


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit C

Comparison of Organizational Documents

This chart highlights material differences between the terms of the Declarations of Trust/Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws of the Buying Funds and Selling Funds.

 

Group A: Selling Fund: Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II. Buying Fund: Columbia Large Cap Core Fund.

 

Group B: Selling Funds: Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund. Buying Funds: Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund.

 

Group C:

Buying Fund: Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly, RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund).1

 

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Shareholder Liability   

Shareholders of the Trust are protected from liability under Delaware statutory law, which provides that shareholders of a Delaware statutory trust have the same limitation of personal liability as is extended to shareholders of a private corporation for profit incorporated in the State of Delaware.

 

In addition, any shareholder or former shareholder exposed to liability by reason of a claim or demand relating solely to his or her being or having been a shareholder of the Trust, and not because of his acts or omissions, the shareholder or former shareholder (or his or her heirs, executors, administrators, or other legal representatives or in the case of a corporation or other entity, its corporate or other general successor) will be entitled to be held harmless from and indemnified out of the assets of the Trust against all loss and expense arising from such claim or demand.

   The shareholders of a Massachusetts business trust could, under certain circumstances, be held personally liable as partners for its obligations. However, the Declaration of Trust contains express disclaimers of shareholder liability for acts, obligations or affairs of the Trust. The Declaration of Trust also provides for indemnification and reimbursement of expenses out of the assets of a series for any shareholder held personally liable for obligations of such series. Therefore, the possibility that a shareholder could be held liable would be limited to a situation in which the assets of the applicable series had been exhausted.    Under Minnesota law, a shareholder’s liability to the corporation or its creditors is limited to paying the amount agreed to be paid for the shares which the shareholder holds or has agreed to purchase.

 

1

The Board of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., has approved the Redomiciling of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, a series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc., into a newly created series of RiverSource Series Trust that has also been named Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (the “Redomiciling”). The Redomiciling is subject to approval by the shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. If the Redomiciling is approved by shareholders of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, the Buying Fund will be governed by charter documents in Group B. If the Redomiciling has not been completed prior to the Closing of the Reorganization, the Buying Fund will be governed by charter documents in Group C.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Shareholder Voting Rights   

Shareholders have only the powers to vote on matters as the Trustees may consider desirable and so authorize, and those voting powers expressly granted under the 1940 Act or under the law of Delaware applicable to statutory trusts.

 

Shares may be voted in person or by proxy or in any manner authorized by the Trustees. On any matter that requires shareholder approval under the 1940 Act, whether shareholders are required to vote by series or class is determined by reference to the 1940 Act. On all other matters, all shares are voted in the aggregate and not by series or class unless the Trustees determine otherwise.

 

Each whole share is entitled to one vote as to any matter on which it is entitled to vote, and each fractional share is entitle to a proportionate fractional vote.

 

There is no cumulative voting in the election of Trustees.

  

At all meetings of shareholders, each shareholder of record is entitled to one vote for each dollar of net asset value (number of shares owned times net asset value per share) and each fractional dollar amount is entitled to a proportionate fractional vote.

 

The shareholders have the power to vote (i) for the election of Trustees, (ii) to the same extent as shareholders of a Massachusetts business corporation as to whether or not a court action, proceeding or claim should or should not be brought or maintained derivatively or as a class action on behalf of the Trust or shareholder, (iii) with respect to termination of the Trust or any class or series of the trust, (iv) with respect to the approval or termination in accordance with the 1940 Act of any contract with any one or more corporations, trusts, associations, partnerships, limited partnerships or other types of organizations, or individuals as to which shareholder approval is required by the 1940 Act, and (v) with respect to additional matters relating to the Trust as may be required by the 1940 Act, the Declaration of Trust, the By-Laws or any registration of the Trust with the SEC (or any successor agency) or any State, or as the Trustees may consider necessary or desirable.

 

On any matter submitted to a vote of shareholders, all shares entitled to vote will be voted in the aggregate as a single class without regard to series or class of shares, except that shares may be voted by individual series or classes (1) when required by the 1940 Act, (2) when the Trustees have determined that the matter affects one or more series or classes of shares materially differently, or (3) when the matter affects only the interests of one or more series or classes.

 

There is no cumulative voting in the election of Trustees.

  

At all meetings of the shareholders, each shareholder of record entitled to vote is entitled to one vote for each dollar of net asset value (number of shares owned times net asset value per share) and each fractional dollar amount is entitled to a proportionate fractional vote.

 

Shareholders have the power to vote (i) for the election of Directors; (ii) on most amendments to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation and on certain amendments to the corporation’s By-Laws; (iii) on certain proposed mergers and exchanges to which the corporation is a party; (iv) on the proposed sale of all or substantially all of the corporation’s property and assets not in the usual and regular course of its business; and (v) on the proposed dissolution of the corporation.

 

At all elections of Directors, each shareholder is entitled to as many votes equal to the number of dollars of net asset value of shares owned multiplied by the number of Directors to be elected and may cast all of such votes for a single Director or may distribute them among the number to be voted for, or any two or more of them.

 

The standard form of certifying resolution creating rights and preferences for series of capital stock provides that each share may be voted by series (i) as required by the provisions of the 1940 Act and all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder; (ii) when the Board of Directors determines that a matter affects series in a materially different way; or (iii) when the Board of Directors determines a matter affects only one or some of the series. In addition, under Minnesota law, shareholders are entitled to vote as separate series or classes with respect to certain amendments to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation and on certain mergers and exchanges to which the corporation is a party.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Shareholder Meetings   

The Trust is not required to hold annual meetings of shareholders.

 

Shareholders have the right to call special meetings and vote to remove Trustees but only if and to the extent the SEC staff takes the position by rule, interpretive letter or public release that Section 16(c) of the 1940 Act gives them such right. Otherwise, only the Trustees, the chairman of the Trustees or the president of the Trust may call shareholder meetings.

  

The Declaration of Trust and By-Laws do not address annual shareholder meetings. Regular shareholder meetings are not required for business trusts under the General Laws of Massachusetts.

 

Shareholder meetings will be held when called by the Trustees for the purpose of taking action on any matter requiring the vote or authority of the shareholders, or for any other matter the Trustees deem necessary or desirable.

  

Regular shareholder meetings are not required; however, a majority of Directors present at a duly held meeting may call a regular meeting of shareholders by fixing the date, time and place for a meeting.

 

If a regular meeting of shareholders has not been held during the immediately preceding 15 months, a shareholder or shareholders holding three percent or more of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote may demand a regular meeting of shareholders by written notice of demand given to the chief executive officer or chief financial officer. Within 30 days after receipt of the demand by one of those officers, the Board of Directors must cause a regular meeting of shareholders to be called and held on notice no later than 90 days after receipt of the demand, all at the expense of the Fund.

 

Special meetings of the shareholders may be called at any time as provided for by the laws of the State of Minnesota.

 

In addition, a special meeting of shareholders may be called at any time by a shareholder or shareholders holding 10% or more of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote, except that a special meeting for the purpose of considering any action to directly or indirectly facilitate or effect a business combination must be called by 25% or more of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote.

 

C-3


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Shareholder Quorum   

Except when a larger quorum is required by applicable law, thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of the shares entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at a shareholders’ meeting. When any one or more series or classes of the Trust is to vote as a single class separate from any other shares, thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of the shares of each such series or classes entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at a shareholder’s meeting of that series.

 

A meeting may be adjourned, whether or not a quorum is present, by the vote of a majority of the shares represented at the meeting, either in person or by proxy. If a meeting is adjourned, notice does not need to be given of the adjourned meeting date unless a new record date for the adjourned meeting is set or unless the adjourned meeting is to take place more than sixty (60) days from the date set for the original meeting, in which case the Board of Trustees would be required to set a new record date.

  

The presence in person or by proxy of 30% of the votes entitled to be cast at a meeting constitutes a quorum.

 

When any one or more series or classes votes as a single class separate from any other shares which are to vote on the same matters as a separate class or classes, 30% of the votes entitled to be cast by each such class entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at a shareholders’ meeting of that class.

 

A meeting may be adjourned by a majority of the votes properly cast upon the question, whether or not a quorum is present, and the meeting may be held as adjourned within a reasonable time after the date set for the original meeting without further notice.

   The holders of at least 10% of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote, present in person or by proxy, constitute a quorum, but the holders of a smaller amount may adjourn without further notice, other than by notice at the time, until a quorum is secured at any such adjourned meeting. In case a quorum is not present, the meeting may be adjourned without notice other than by notice at the meeting. At any adjourned meeting at which a quorum may be present, any business may be transacted which might have been transacted at the meeting as originally called.
Shareholder Consent    Any action taken by shareholders may be taken without a meeting if shareholders holding a majority of the shares entitled to vote on the matter and holding a majority of the shares of any series or class entitled to vote separately on the matter consent to the action in writing and such written consents are filed with the records of the meetings of shareholders. Such consent is treated for all purposes as a vote taken at a meeting of shareholders.    Except as otherwise provided by law, the Declaration of Trust or the By-Laws, any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of shareholders may be taken without a meeting if a majority of the shareholders entitled to vote consent to the action in writing and the consents are filed with the records of the Trust. The consent will be treated for all purposes as a vote taken at a meeting of shareholders.    An action required or permitted to be taken at a shareholder meeting may be taken by written action signed, or consented to by authorized electronic communication, by all of the shareholders entitled to vote on that action. Such a written action is not effective if it is signed or consented to by fewer than all the shareholders entitled to vote on the action.

 

C-4


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Notice to Shareholders of Record Date   

Notice of any meeting of shareholders must be given by the Trustees, chairman of the Trustees or president not less than 7 days nor more than 120 days before the date of the meeting.

 

The Trustees may set a record date for the purpose of determining the shareholders entitled to vote or act at a shareholders’ meeting. The record date cannot be more than 120 days before the date of the meeting.

  

Written notice of any meeting of shareholders must be given by the Trustees at least 7 days before the meeting.

 

The Trustees may set a record date for the purpose of determining the shareholders entitled to notice of or to vote at a shareholder meeting. The record date cannot be more than 90 days or less than 7 days before the date of the meeting.

  

In general, shareholders who are entitled to vote at a shareholder meeting must be given notice of the meeting at least ten and not more than 60 days before the meeting. In certain cases, the notice of meeting must include specified information required by Minnesota law.

 

The Board of Directors can establish a record date for determining the shareholders who are entitled to vote at a shareholder meeting. The record date cannot be more than 60 days before the date of the meeting.

Shareholder Proxies   

Shareholders my vote in person or by proxy.

 

Unless the Trustees declare otherwise, proxies may be given by any electronic or telecommunications device, including telefacsimile, telephone or through the Internet, but if a proposal by anyone other than the officers or Trustees is submitted to a vote of the shareholders of any series or class, or if there is a proxy contest or proxy solicitation or proposal in opposition to any proposal by the officers or Trustees, shares may be voted only in person or by written proxy unless the Trustees specifically authorize other permissible methods of transmission.

 

The Trustees may appoint inspectors for any meeting of shareholders, and these inspectors are charged with, among other things, determining the authenticity, validity and effect of proxies

  

Shareholders may vote in person or by proxy.

 

A proxy with respect to shares held in the name of two or more persons will be valid if executed by any one of them unless at or prior to exercise of the proxy the Trust receives a specific written notice to the contrary from any one of them. A proxy purporting to be executed by or on behalf of a shareholder will be deemed valid unless challenged at or prior to its exercise and the burden of proving invalidity rests on the challenger.

  

At each shareholder meeting, the polls may be opened and closed, the proxies and ballots may be received and taken in charge, and all questions touching the qualification of voters, the validity of proxies, and acceptances or rejections of votes may be decided by two (2) inspectors of election.

 

Minnesota law provides that shareholders can submit proxies in writing or by telephonic transmission or authenticated electronic communication. It also provides that the Board of Directors can establish procedures whereby a record holder can certify in writing that another person is the beneficial owner of shares, and the beneficial owner then can vote the shares or appoint a proxy.

 

C-5


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Director/Trustee Power to Amend Organizational Document    The Trustees may, without shareholder vote, amend or otherwise supplement the Declaration of Trust; provided that shareholders have the right to vote on any amendment if expressly required under Delaware law or the 1940 Act, or submitted to shareholders by the Trustees at their discretion.   

The Trustees may amend the Declaration of Trust at any time by an instrument in writing signed by a majority of the then Trustees provided that notice of such amendment is transmitted promptly to shareholders of record.

 

The Trustees need not, however, provide notice of an amendment if the amendment is for the purpose of supplying an omission, curing any ambiguity or curing, correcting or supplementing any defective or inconsistent provision contained in the Declaration of Trust, or having any other purpose which is ministerial or clerical in nature.

   The Articles of Incorporation may be amended, altered, changed or repealed in a manner prescribed by the laws of the State of Minnesota.
Termination of Corporation/Trust    The Trust and any series thereof may be terminated at any time by the Board of Trustees with written notice to shareholders. To the extent the 1940 Act expressly allows shareholders the power to vote on such terminations, the Trust or any series thereof may be terminated by a vote of a majority of shares entitled to vote.   

The Trust may be terminated by the Trustees with written notice to shareholders, or by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the shares of each series entitled to vote.

 

Any series of or class may be terminated by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the shares of that series or class, or by the Trustees by written notice to the shareholders of that series or class.

  

In order to dissolve a Minnesota corporation, the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote is required. In order to discontinue an individual class or series of shares without dissolving the corporation, an amendment to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation is required. In order to adopt such an amendment, shareholders must approve the amendment by the affirmative vote of the greater of (i) a majority of the voting power of the shares of that class or series present and entitled to vote or (ii) a majority of the voting power of the minimum number of shares of such class or series entitled to vote that would constitute a quorum for the transaction of business at the meeting (a “Minnesota Statutory Vote”).

 

The Board of Directors, acting without a shareholder vote, does not have the power to dissolve the corporation or to discontinue an individual class or series of shares.

 

C-6


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Merger or Consolidation    The Trustees have the power to cause the Trust or any series to be merged or consolidated with another trust or company. The Trustees may accomplish such merger or consolidation with written notice to shareholders but without the vote of shareholders, unless such shareholder vote is required by law.    Subject to applicable laws, the Trustees may, without shareholder consent, cause the Trust or any series to be merged or consolidated with another trust or company. The Trustees may also transfer all or a substantial portion of the Trust’s assets to another fund or company.   

In most cases, any merger or exchange in which a Minnesota corporation is not the continuing entity, and any sale of all or substantially all of the corporation’s property and assets not in the usual and regular course of its business, requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote.

 

Any sale of the assets belonging to an individual series of shares of a Minnesota corporation in exchange for shares of another corporation or trust or shares of another series of the corporation, while leaving other series of the corporation outstanding, would require an amendment to the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation. In order to adopt such an amendment, shareholders of that series would have to approve the amendment by a Minnesota Statutory Vote.

Removal of Directors/Trustees   

A Trustee may be removed with or without cause at any time by a written instrument signed by at least two-thirds of the other Trustees.

 

In addition, if required by Section 16(c) of the 1940 Act, any Trustee may be removed at any meeting of the shareholders by a vote of at least two-thirds of the outstanding shares.

   Trustees may be removed with or without cause by majority vote of the Trustees.   

Under Minnesota law, the Board of Directors can remove a Director by a majority vote of the remaining Directors, but only if the Director was appointed by the Board of Directors to fill a vacancy and has not subsequently been elected by shareholders.

 

In all other cases, a Director can only be removed by shareholder vote. In general, such removal requires the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the voting power of all shares entitled to vote at an election of Directors. However, where a corporation has cumulative voting (as do the Funds), unless the entire Board of Directors is removed simultaneously, a Director is not removed from the Board of Directors if there are cast against removal of the Director the votes of a proportion of the voting power sufficient to elect the Director at an election of the entire Board of Directors under cumulative voting.

 

C-7


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Director/Trustee Committees   

The Trust has two standing committees that may not be abolished: the Audit Committee and the Nominating Committee. Otherwise, the Trustees may, with a majority vote of the Trustees, appoint from their number other committees consisting of two or more Trustees which may be delegated such authority as the Trustees consider desirable. The Trustees may also abolish the non-standing committees with a majority vote of the Trustees.

 

Each committee may elect a chair and each committee must maintain records of its meetings and report its actions to the full Board of Trustees.

 

A majority of the authorized number of committee members shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business of such committee, unless the Board of Trustees designates a lower percentage.

   The Trustees may appoint from their own number and terminate committees consisting of one or more Trustees, which may exercise the powers and authority of the Trustees to the extent that the Trustees determine.   

The corporation’s By-Laws provide that the Board of Directors may, by resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board of Directors, designate an Executive Committee of two or more Directors, which may meet at stated times or on notice to all by any of their number during intervals between meetings of the Board of Directors. The Executive Committee will advise with and aid the officers of the Fund in all matters concerning its interests and the management of its business, and generally perform such duties and exercise such powers as may be delegated to it from time to time by the Board of Directors.

 

The Board of Directors also may, by resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board of Directors, appoint any other committee or committees for any purpose or purposes, which committee or committees will have such powers as specified in the resolution of appointment. The quorum for such committee established by the Board of Directors is two members regardless of the number of members serving on the committee.

Director/Trustee Liability    Trustees will be liable to the Trust by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of the Trustee’s office.   

Trustees are not subject to personal liability, except by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of the office of Trustee. Additionally, Trustees are not personally liable for any neglect or wrong-doing of any officer, agent, or employee of the Trust or for any act or omission of any other Trustee.

 

Trustees that are singled out as experts on particular issues, such as a chair of a committee, are not held to any higher standard than their non-expert counterparts.

  

To the full extent permitted by the laws of the State of Minnesota, no Director of the Fund will be liable to the Fund or to its shareholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a Director but such limit on liability will be permitted only to the extent allowable under the provisions of the 1940 Act.

 

Under Minnesota law, the foregoing provision is not effective to eliminate a Director’s personal liability to the Funds or its shareholders for, among other things, (i) any breach of the Director’s duty of loyalty to the corporation or its shareholders; (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or that involve intentional misconduct or knowing violation of law; or (iii) any transaction from which the Director derived an improper personal benefit.

 

C-8


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Director/Trustee Indemnification   

The Trust indemnifies the Trustees against expenses, judgments, fines and settlements and other amounts actually and reasonably incurred in connection with any civil or criminal proceeding or investigations, if it is determined that the Trustee acted in good faith and reasonably believed 1) that his or her conduct was in the Trust’s best interests, and 2) that his or her conduct was at least not opposed to the Trust’s best interests, and 3) in the case of a criminal proceeding, that he or she had no reasonable cause to believe that the conduct was unlawful.

 

A Trustee will not, however, be indemnified 1) with respect to any matters where the Trustee is judged to be liable on the basis that a personal benefit was improperly received, whether or not the benefit resulted from action taken in that Trustee’s official capacity, 2) with respect to any matter where the Trustee is judged to be liable in the performance of his or her duty to the Trust unless the adjudicator determines that the Trustee was not liable as the result of conduct in (1) above and that the Trustee is fairly entitled to indemnification, and 3) with respect to amounts paid to settle or dispose of an action with or without court approval unless a) approved by a majority vote of a quorum of Trustees who are not parties and are disinterested persons, or b) a written opinion of counsel is obtained.

 

Expenses incurred in defending any proceeding may be advanced by the Trust before the final disposition of a proceeding upon a written undertaking by the Trustee to repay the amount advanced if it is ultimately determined that he or she is not entitled to indemnification, together with at least on of the following conditions to the advance: 1) security for the undertaking, 2) the existence of insurance protecting the Trust against losses arising by reason of any lawful advances, or 3) a determination by a majority of a quorum of the Trustees who are not parties to the proceeding and are not interested persons of the Trust, or by an independent legal counsel, based on a review of the readily available facts that there is reason to believe that the Trustee ultimately will be found entitled to indemnification.

  

The Trust indemnifies each of its Trustees against all liabilities and expenses, including amounts paid in satisfaction of judgments, in compromise or as fines and penalties, and attorneys’ fees incurred in connection with the defense of any civil or criminal suit or action, except with respect to any matter (i) as to which a Trustee is finally adjudicated in any such action or proceeding not to have acted in good faith in reasonable belief that such Trustee’s action was in the best interests of the Trust; or (ii) where the Trustee acted in willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of such Trustee’s office.

 

Expenses, including counsel fees, so incurred by any such Trustee (but excluding amounts paid in satisfaction of judgments, in compromise or as fines or penalties) will be paid from time to time by the Trust in advance of the final disposition of any such action, suit or proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such Trustee to repay amounts so paid to the Trust if it is ultimately determined that indemnification of such expenses is not authorized under the By-Laws, provided, however, that either (a) such Trustee shall have provided appropriate security for such undertaking, (b) the Trust shall be insured against losses arising from any such advance payments, or (c) either a majority of the disinterested Trustees acting on the matter (provided that a majority of the disinterested Trustees then in office act on the matter), or independent legal counsel in a written opinion, will have determined, based upon a review of readily available facts, that there is reason to believe that such Trustee will be found entitled to indemnification under the By-Laws.

  

Each person made or threatened to be made a party to or is involved (including, without limitation, as a witness) in any actual or threatened action, suit or proceeding whether civil, criminal, administrative, arbitration, or investigative, including a proceeding by or in the right of the Fund by reason of the former or present capacity as a Director of the Fund or who, while a Director of the Fund, is or was serving at the request of the Fund or whose duties as a Director involve or involved service as a director, officer, partner, trustee or agent of another organization or employee benefit plan, whether the basis of any proceeding is alleged action in an official capacity or in any capacity while serving as a director, officer, partner, trustee or agent, will be indemnified and held harmless by the Fund to the full extent authorized by the Minnesota Business Corporation Act, as the same or may hereafter be amended (but, in the case of any such amendment, only to the extent that such amendment permits the Fund to provide broader indemnification rights than the law permitted the Fund to provide prior to such amendment, or by any other applicable law as then in effect, against judgments, penalties, fines including, without limitation, excise taxes assessed against the person with respect to an employee benefit plan, settlements and reasonable expenses, including attorneys’ fees and disbursements, incurred in connection therewith and such indemnification will continue as to any person who has ceased to be a Director or officer and will inure to the benefit of the person’s heirs, executors and administrators provided, however, in an action brought against the Fund to enforce rights to indemnification, the Director will be indemnified only if the action was authorized by the Board of Directors of the Fund. The right to indemnification conferred by the Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws is a contract right and includes the right to be paid by the Fund in advance of the final disposition of a proceeding for expenses incurred in connection therewith provided, however, such payment of expenses will be made only upon receipt of a written undertaking by the Director to repay all amounts so paid if it is ultimately determined that the Director is not entitled to indemnification.

 

Any indemnification under the Articles of Incorporation or the By-Laws is not exclusive of any other rights of indemnification to which the Directors might otherwise be entitled. No indemnification will be made in violation of the Investment Company Act of 1940.

 

C-9


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Dividends    The Trustees may declare and pay dividends and distributions to shareholders of each series from the assets of such series.    Dividends and distributions may be paid to shareholders from the Trust’s net income with the frequency as the Trustees may determine.    The corporation’s Articles of Incorporation provide that the Directors may declare and pay dividends in their discretion at any time and from time to time to the extent and from such sources as permitted by the laws of the State of Minnesota. Under Minnesota law, the Board of Directors can authorize a dividend if it determines that the corporation will be able to pay its debts in the ordinary course of business after paying the dividend.
Capitalization   

The beneficial interest in the Trust shall at all times be divided into an unlimited number of shares, without

par value.

   The beneficial interest in the Trust shall at all times be divided into an unlimited number of shares without par value.    The Corporation’s articles of incorporation authorize the issuance of up to 10,000,000,000 shares of stock with a par value of $.01 per share. The Board of Directors can authorize the issuance of shares in such classes or series with such designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights, or qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, as are stated in the Board resolution establishing the class or series. The Board of Directors can, without shareholder approval, increase or decrease the total number of authorized shares, or the authorized shares of a class or series, in the manner and to the extent set forth under “Directors’ Power to Amend Articles of Incorporation/Trustees’ Power to Amend Declaration of Trust” above.

 

C-10


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Number of Directors/Trustees and Vacancies   

The number of Trustees may be fixed by the Trustees from time to time by a written instrument signed, or a resolution approved at a duly constituted meeting, by a majority of the Trustees. Provided, however, that the number of Trustees cannot be fewer than 1 or more than 15.

 

Vacancies in the Board of Trustees may be filled by a majority of the remaining Trustees, even if less than a quorum, or by a sole remaining Trustee, unless the Trustees call a meeting of shareholders for the purpose of electing Trustees. In the event that at any time less than a majority of the Trustees holding office at that time were so elected by shareholders, the Board of Trustees will hold a shareholders’ meeting within 60 days for the election of Trustees to fill such vacancies on the board.

  

The Trustees may fix the number of Trustees, fill vacancies in the Trustees, including vacancies arising from an increase in the number of Trustees, or remove Trustees with or without cause.

 

Shareholders may fix the number of Trustees and elect Trustees at any meeting of Shareholders called by the Trustees for that purpose and to the extent required by applicable law, including paragraphs (a) and (b) of Section 16 of the 1940 Act.

 

Each Trustee serves during the continued lifetime of the Trust until he or she dies, resigns or is removed, or, if sooner, until the next meeting of Shareholders called for the purpose of electing Trustees and until the election and qualification of his or her successor.

   There may be no fewer than two or more than 15 Directors. If a vacancy occurs in the Board of Directors by reason of death, resignation or otherwise, such vacancy may be filled for the unexpired term by a majority vote of the remaining Directors, even if the remaining number of Directors is less than a quorum.
Independent Chair of the Board    The Declaration of Trust does not require an independent chair of the Board of Trustees.    The Declaration of Trust and By-Laws do not require an independent chair of the board of Trustees.    The Corporation’s By-Laws require the Board of Directors to elect one independent member to serve as Chair of the Board of Directors whose duties include serving as the lead independent Director.

 

C-11


Table of Contents

Policy

  

Group A

  

Group B

  

Group C

Inspection of Books and Records    The original or a copy of the Declaration of Trust, and of each amendment thereto, is kept at the office of the Trust where it may be inspected by any shareholder.    The original or a copy of the Declaration of Trust, and of each amendment thereto, is kept at the office of the Trust where it may be inspected by any shareholder.    Minnesota law requires the corporation (each Fund) to keep (i) a share register containing the names and addresses of its shareholders and the number and classes of shares held by each; (ii) records of all proceedings of shareholders for the last three years; (iii) records of all proceedings of the Board of Directors for the last three years; (iv) its Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws, as amended; (v) certain financial statements which Minnesota law requires the corporation (each Fund) to prepare; (vi) all reports to shareholders generally within the last three years; and (vii) a statement of the names and usual business addresses of its Directors and principal officers. The Fund’s shareholders and beneficial owners have the right, upon written demand stating the purpose, at any reasonable time to examine and copy those records which are reasonably related to the stated purpose, provided that the stated purpose is reasonably related to the person’s interest as a shareholder or beneficial owner.
Involuntary Redemption of Accounts    The Trustees may redeem, repurchase and transfer shares pursuant to applicable law.    The Trust has the right at its option and at any time to redeem shares of any shareholder at the net asset value thereof: (i) if at such time such shareholder owns shares of any series or class having an aggregate net asset value of less than an amount determined from time to time by the Trustees; or (ii) to the extent that such shareholder owns shares equal to or in excess of a percentage determined from time to time by the Trustees of the outstanding shares of the Trust or of any series or class.    The Fund may redeem the shares of a shareholder if the amount invested is less than an amount determined by the Board of Directors and set forth in the current Fund prospectus.

 

C-12


Table of Contents

 

D. Executive Officer and Director Information

Information regarding the current executive officers of the Columbia Funds Series Trust, and the principal executive officer and directors of Columbia Management, is shown below.

 

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust and Year
First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Position with
Columbia
Management and
Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

J. Kevin Connaughton

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

President (Principal Executive Officer)

(2009)

  

Senior Vice President
and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products

(2010)

   President, RiverSource Funds since 2010; Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Columbia Funds, June 2008 – January 2009); President, Atlantic Funds and Nations Funds since 2009; Managing Director of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, December 2004 – April 2010; Treasurer, Columbia Funds, October 2003 – May 2008; Treasurer, the Liberty Funds, Stein Roe Funds and Liberty All-Start Funds, December 2000 – December 2006; Senior Vice President – Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, April 2003 – December 2004; President, Columbia Funds, Liberty Funds and Stein Roe Funds, February 2004 – October 2004

Michael G. Clarke

(Born 1969)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)

(2009)

  

Vice President

(2010)

   Managing Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from September 2004 to April 2010; senior officer of Columbia Funds and affiliated funds since 2002.

Scott R. Plummer

(Born 1959)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer

(2010)

  

Vice President and Chief Legal Officer

(2005)

   Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, from 2005 to April 2010, and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance from 2004 to 2005); Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, RiverSource Funds, since December 2006; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since May 2010.

Linda J. Wondrack

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer

(2007)

  

Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer

(2010)

   Vice President, RiverSource Funds, since May 2010; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, from June 2005 to April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer of MFS Investment Management (investment management) from August 2004 to May 2005.

William F. Truscott

(Born 1960)

53600 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Senior Vice President

(2010)

  

Chairman of the Board (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer from 2001 to April 2010)

(2001)

   Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President, Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer from 2005 to April 2010, and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to 2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer from 2008 to April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006.

Colin Moore

(Born 1958)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Senior Vice President

(2010)

  

Director and Chief Investment Officer

(2010)

   Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2002 to 2007.

 

D-1


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust and Year
First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Position with
Columbia
Management and
Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Michael A. Jones

(Born 1959)

100 Federal Street

Boston, MA 02110

  

Senior Vice President

(2010)

  

President and Director

(2010)

   President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Vice President, RiverSource Funds, since 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from November 2006 to April 2010; previously, co-president and senior managing director at Robeco Investment Management.

Amy K. Johnson

(Born 1965)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Senior Vice President

(2010)

  

Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer

(2010)

   Chief Administrative Officer, Columbia Management, 2009 – April 2010 (previously Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, 2006 – 2009 and Vice President – Operations and Compliance, 2004 – 2006); Vice President, RiverSource Funds, since 2006; Director of Product Development – Mutual Funds, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. 2001 – 2004

Joseph F. DiMaria

(Born 1968)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Treasurer and Chief Accounting Officer

(2008)

  

Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration

(2010)

   Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2006 to April 2010; Head of Tax/Compliance and Assistant Treasurer, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from November 2004 to December 2005.

Marybeth Pilat

(Born 1968)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Deputy Treasurer

(2010)

  

Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration

(2010)

   Vice President, Investment Operations, Bank of America, from October 2008 to April 2010; Finance Manager, Boston Children’s Hospital from August 2008 to October 2008; Director, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from May 2007 to July 2008; Vice President, Mutual Fund Valuation, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from January 2006 to May 2007; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2005 to January 2006.

Julian Quero

(Born 1967)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Deputy Treasurer

(2008)

  

Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration

(2010)

   Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from August 2008 to April 2010; Senior Tax Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from August 2006 to July 2008; Senior Compliance Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from April 2002 to August 2006.

Stephen T. Welsh

(Born 1957)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Vice President

(2006)

  

President and Director

(2010)

   President and Director, Columbia Management Services, Inc. from July 2004 to April 2010; Managing Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from August 2007 to April 2010.

Kathryn Thompson

(Born 1967)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Assistant Treasurer

(2006)

   [None]    Director, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight and Treasury of Columbia Management, since May 2010; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight of the Previous Adviser from December 2004 to April 2010; Vice President, State Street Corporation (financial services) prior to December 2004.

Paul B. Goucher

(Born 1968)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Assistant Secretary

(2010)

   [None]    Vice President and Chief Counsel of Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel from November 2008 to January 2010); Director, Managing Director and General Counsel of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated (Seligman) from July 2008 to November 2008 and Managing Director and Associate General Counsel of Seligman from January 2005 to July 2008.

Ryan C. Larrenaga

(Born 1970)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

  

Assistant Secretary

(2005)

   [None]    Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since May 2010; Assistant General Counsel, Bank of America from March 2005 to April 2010; Associate, Ropes & Gray LLP (law firm) from 1998 to February 2005.

 

D-2


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust and Year
First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Position with
Columbia
Management and
Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office

  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Christopher O. Petersen

(Born 1970)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

  

Assistant Secretary

(2010)

   [None]    Vice President and Chief Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel or Counsel from April 2004 to January 2010); Assistant Secretary of RiverSource Funds since January 2007.

Brian J. McGrane

[ADDRESS]

   [None]    Director, Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer    [•]

 

D-3


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit E. Trustee Compensation

Total trustees’ fees paid by Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II and the Columbia Funds Series Trust to the Independent Trustees and Interested Trustees are listed below. No trustee listed below received pension or retirement benefits accrued as part of the Fund’s expenses in the Fund’s last fiscal year. All trustees receive reimbursements for reasonable expenses related to their attendance at meetings of the Columbia Nations Board or standing committees, which are not reflected in the amounts shown.

Independent Trustee Compensation from Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

 

     Aggregate Compensation from Fund
Independent Trustees
 
     Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
     William P.
Carmichael2
     Minor M.
Shaw3
     R. Glenn
Hilliard4
     William A.
Hawkins5
     John J.
Nagorniak6
 

Fund

                 
                                                     

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 4,608       $ 5,546       $ 4,452       $ 4,530       $ 4,608       $ 3,908   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,571       $ 0       $ 2,226       $ 0       $ 83       $ 1,173   

 

1

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Boudreau deferred $81,627 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Boudreau’s account thereunder was $286,846.

2

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Carmichael deferred $0 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Carmichael’s account thereunder was $1,056,273.

3

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Shaw deferred $132,587 of her total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Shaw’s account thereunder was $576,224.

4

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Hilliard deferred $31,154 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Hilliard’s account thereunder was $605,201.

5

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Hawkins deferred $0 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Hawkins’s account thereunder was $0.

6

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Nagorniak deferred $69,170 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Nagorniak’s account thereunder was $130,303.

Interested Trustee Compensation from the Funds

 

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

 
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

7

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Dr. Santomero deferred $122,207 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the Deferred Compensation Agreement. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Dr. Santomero’s account thereunder was $203,951.

Independent Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

    

Total Compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex
Paid to Independent Trustees for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

   $295,000

William P. Carmichael

   $357,500

Minor M. Shaw

   $287,500

R. Glenn Hilliard

   $290,000

William A. Hawkins

   $297,500

John J. Nagorniak

   $250,000

Interested Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

    

Total Compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex
Paid to Interested Trustees for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

Anthony M. Santomero

   $265,000

 

E-1


Table of Contents

 

F. Share Ownership of Nominees

As of December 31, 2009, the Nominees and officers of Columbia Funds Series Trust, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of each class of shares of each Fund. The table below shows, for each Nominee, the value of investments in shares of each Fund beneficially owned by the Nominee. It also shows the aggregate value of all investments in shares of the Combined Funds Complex overseen or to be overseen by the Nominees, including notional amounts owned through the Deferred Compensation Agreement. Ownership information is presented in the following ranges: A = $0; B = $1-$10,000; C = $10,001-$50,000; D = $50,001-$100,000; and E = over $100,000.

Independent Nominee Ownership as of December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   Kathleen
Blatz
   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.
   Pamela G.
Carlton
  William P.
Carmichael
   Patricia M.
Flynn
  William A.
Hawkins

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   N/A    B    N/A   D    N/A   A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee (including notional amounts owned through the Deferred Compensation Agreement)

   E    E    E*   E    E*   A

 

Fund

   R. Glenn
Hilliard
   Stephen R.
Lewis, Jr.
  John F.
Maher
  John J.
Nagorniak
   Catherine
James Paglia
  Leroy C.
Richie

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   A    N/A   N/A   A    N/A   N/A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee (including notional amounts owned through the Deferred Compensation Agreement)

   E    E*   E*   E    E*   E

 

Fund

   Alison Taunton-
Rigby
   Minor M.
Shaw

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   N/A    A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee (including notional amounts owned through the Deferred Compensation Agreement)

   E    E

Interested Nominee Ownership as of December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   William F.
Truscott
  Anthony M.
Santomero

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

   [•]   A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Shares in all Funds in the Combined Funds Complex Overseen or to be Overseen by the Nominee (including notional amounts owned through the Deferred Compensation Agreement)

     E

 

* Total includes deferred compensation invested in share equivalents.

 

F-1


Table of Contents

 

G. Columbia Funds Series Trust’s Governance Committee Charter

 

1. Membership. The governance committees (each, a “Governance Committee” and collectively, the “Governance Committees”) of the Boards of Trustees (the “Boards”) of Columbia Funds Series Trust, Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC, Columbia Funds Variable Insurance Trust I and Banc of America Funds Trust (each, a “Fund Company” and collectively, the “Fund Companies”) shall be composed entirely of Trustees who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940) of any Fund Company’s series (each, a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”), or any Fund’s investment adviser or principal underwriter (the “Independent Trustees”).

Each Board shall designate the members of its Governance Committee and shall either designate the Chairman or approve the method of selecting the Chairman. Each Governance Committee may include advisory members and/or “ex officio” members, who shall be entitled to participate in all meetings but shall not be entitled to vote with respect to matters considered by such Governance Committee. Unless the Chairman of a Fund Company’s Board is designated as a full member of that Board’s Governance Committee, the Chairman of the Board shall be an ex officio member of that Governance Committee.

 

2. Purpose. Each Governance Committee has been established to make recommendations to its Board on issues related to the Independent Trustees and the composition and operation of the Board and to assume the duties, responsibilities and functions of the Board’s pre-existing Nominating Committee together with such additional duties, responsibilities and functions as are delegated to it from time to time.

The primary responsibilities of each Governance Committee include:

 

  a. generally overseeing issues of corporate governance of the Fund Companies;

 

  b. nominating Independent Trustees;

 

  c. addressing matters relating to compensation of Trustees who are not current directors, officers or employees of a Fund’s investment adviser or sub-adviser or any control affiliate thereof (“Unaffiliated Trustees”), including deferred compensation and retirement policies; and

 

  d. evaluating its Board and the Board’s committee structure as often as the Governance Committee deems necessary or desirable to determine whether each is functioning effectively. Each Governance Committee shall determine the nature of the evaluation and its role therein in its sole discretion.

 

3. Specific Responsibilities and Powers. Each Governance Committee has the responsibility and power to:

 

  a. consider, as it deems necessary or appropriate, the candidacy of persons to fill existing or newly created Trustee vacancies, taking into consideration, among other factors that each Governance Committee may determine in its sole judgment, any or all of the following attributes: leadership, independence, interpersonal skills, financial acumen, business experience, industry knowledge and diversity of background or viewpoint. In considering candidates, each Board and its Governance Committee believe that no specific qualification or characteristic is controlling or paramount, or that specific qualities or skills are necessary for each candidate to possess;

 

  b. periodically assess, as it deems necessary or appropriate, the criteria for selection of potential Independent Trustees;

 

  c. identify and evaluate Independent Trustee candidates according to the relevant criteria;

 

  d.

consider candidates submitted by shareholders or from other sources as it deems appropriate. Each Governance Committee shall be solely responsible for the selection and recommendation of candidates to its Board. Any recommendation should be submitted to Columbia Funds, c/o Secretary, at the principal address shown on its registration statement. Any submission should include at a minimum the following information as to each individual proposed for election or re-election as Trustee: the name, age, business address, residence address and principal occupation or employment of such individual, the class, series and number of shares of stock of any Fund that are beneficially owned by such individual, the date such shares were acquired and the investment intent of such acquisition, whether such stockholder believes such individual would or would not qualify as an Independent Trustee, and information regarding

 

G-1


Table of Contents
 

such individual that is sufficient, in the discretion of the Governance Committee, to make such determination, and all other information relating to such individual that is required to be disclosed in solicitation of proxies for election of board members in an election contest (even if an election contest is not involved) or is otherwise required, in each case pursuant to Regulation 14A (or any successor provision) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules thereunder (including such individual’s written consent to being named in the proxy statement as a nominee and to serving as a Trustee (if elected)).

In the case of any Fund Company holding a meeting of shareholders for the election of Trustees, shareholder submissions will be considered for inclusion in the Fund’s proxy statement only if submitted by a date not earlier than the 365th calendar day before, and not later than the 60th calendar day before, the date on which the Fund Company’s Board has set a meeting date for the shareholder meeting at which the election of Trustees is to be considered. Any such submission must also contain such information as may be required by any relevant rule or regulation;

 

  e. periodically review and make recommendations to its full Board regarding Unaffiliated Trustee compensation;

 

  f. initiate, oversee and recommend changes to retirement and deferred compensation plans for its Unaffiliated Trustees;

 

  g. consider, oversee and implement any evaluation process of its Board, which may include evaluation of the structure, frequency and length of meetings, the structure and composition of the Board and Governance Committee and the general deliberative process of the Board, including information flow;

 

  h. report its activities to its full Board and to make such recommendations with respect to the matters described above and other matters as the Governance Committee may deem necessary or appropriate;

 

  i. establish, arrange for and coordinate the participation in, new Trustee orientation and continuing education or information programs for Trustees, as they deem appropriate. Any related costs shall be borne by the Funds; and

 

  j. evaluate on at least an annual basis the independence of counsel to the Independent Trustees, to make recommendations to the Independent Trustees regarding their determination of such counsel’s status as an “independent legal counsel” under applicable SEC rules, and to address matters relating to such engagement as the Committee deems appropriate.

 

4. Procedural Matters.

 

  a. Each Governance Committee shall meet as often as it deems necessary. Each Governance Committee shall record minutes of meetings and shall invite management, counsel and representatives of service providers to attend meetings and provide information to each such Governance Committee as it may consider appropriate.

 

  b. Each Governance Committee shall conduct an annual self-evaluation of its performance and review this Charter as often as it deems appropriate in order to recommend any changes to its full Board. Each Governance Committee shall have such further responsibilities as are given to it from time to time by the Board. Each Governance Committee shall consult, as often as it deems appropriate, with management and counsel to the Company and to the Independent Trustees as to legal or regulatory developments affecting their responsibilities.

 

  c. Each Governance Committee shall have the resources and authority appropriate to discharge its responsibilities, including the authority to retain special counsel and other experts or consultants at the expense of the Funds. Each Governance Committee shall have the sole authority to retain and terminate any search firm to be used to identify Trustee candidates, including sole authority to approve the search firm’s fee and other retention terms.

Adopted: August 24, 2000

Last Amended: February 25, 2009

 

G-2


Table of Contents

 

STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

[], 2010

This Statement of Additional Information (the “SAI”) relates to the following proposed reorganizations (the “Reorganizations”):

 

  1. Reorganization of Columbia Blended Equity Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust (a “Buying Fund”).

 

  2. Reorganization of each of Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I, and Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I, (each a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Buying Fund”).

 

  3. Reorganization of Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust (a “Selling Fund”) into Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Buying Fund”).

 

  4. Reorganization of Columbia Disciplined Value Fund, a series of Columbia Funds Series Trust I (a “Selling Fund”), into Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund), a series of RiverSource Investment Series, Inc. (a “Buying Fund”).

This SAI contains information which may be of interest to shareholders of the Selling Funds but which is not included in the combined Prospectus/Proxy Statement dated [] (the “Proxy Statement/Prospectus”) which relates to the Reorganizations. As described in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus, the Reorganizations would involve the transfer of all the assets of each Selling Fund in exchange for shares of the Buying Fund and the assumption of all the liabilities of each Selling Fund by the Buying Fund. Each Selling Fund would distribute the Buying Fund shares it receives to its shareholders in complete liquidation of each Selling Fund. This SAI is not a prospectus and should be read in conjunction with the Proxy Statement/Prospectus. The Proxy Statement/Prospectus has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and is available upon request and without charge by writing to the Buying Funds at c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, or by calling 800.345.6611.


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

Additional Information About Each Buying Fund

     1   

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

     3   

Financial Statements

     3   

Appendix A – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

     A-1   

Appendix B – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Strategic Investor Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

     B-1   

Appendix C Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

     C-1   

Appendix D Pro forma financial statements of Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I and Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

     D-1   

 


Table of Contents

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ABOUT EACH BUYING FUND

Attached hereto as Appendix A is the Statement of Additional Information of the Columbia Large Cap Core Fund dated September 27, 2010 as supplemented.

Attached hereto as Appendix B is the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Strategic Investor Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I, dated November 1, 2010 as supplemented.

 

1


Table of Contents

Attached hereto as Appendix C is the Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, dated October 29, 2010 as supplemented.

 

2


Table of Contents

 

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRMS

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, located at 125 High Street, Boston, MA 02110-1707, is the independent registered public accounting firm for Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I, providing audit and tax return review services and assistance and consultation in connection with the review of various Securities and Exchange Commission filings. Ernst & Young, LLP, located at 220 South 6th Street, Suite 1400, Minneapolis, MN 55402, is the independent registered public accounting firm for Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, providing audit and other accounting and tax-related services as requested by Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund. The Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, Financial Highlights and Financial Statements included in Columbia Large Cap Core Fund’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended February 28, 2010 and Semiannual Report to Shareholders for the Period ended August 31, 2010; Columbia Strategic Investor Fund’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended August 31, 2010; Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended August 31, 2010 and Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2009 and Semiannual Report to Shareholders for the Period ended March 31, 2010 are incorporated by reference into this SAI. The audited financial statements for Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I included in their respective Annual Reports to Shareholders and incorporated by reference into this SAI have been so included and incorporated in reliance upon the reports of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, given on their authority as experts in auditing and accounting. The audited financial statements for Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund incorporated by reference into this SAI have been so included and incorporated in reliance upon the reports of Ernst & Young LLP, given on their authority as experts in auditing and accounting. The audited financial statements for Columbia Blended Equity Fund; Columbia Select Opportunities Fund; Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund; Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II; and Columbia Disciplined Value Fund incorporated by reference to the Proxy Statement/Prospectus have been so included and incorporated in reliance upon the reports of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, given on their authority as experts in auditing and accounting.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Pro forma financial statements of the Buying Funds for the Reorganizations are attached hereto as Appendix D.

 

3


Table of Contents

 

Appendix A Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management®

 

  COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST
  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 

September 27, 2010

 

Fund

              

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class A: PHAAX

   Class B: NBASX    Class C: NAACX    Class Z: NPRAX

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NACMX

   Class B: —      Class C: —      Class Z: NCMAX

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class A: PACIX

   Class B: NCVBX    Class C: PHIKX    Class I: —  

Class Z: NCIAX

        

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NGIMX

   Class B: NGITX    Class C: NGINX    Class Z: NGAMX

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class A: NVVAX

   Class B: NGLBX    Class C: NCGLX    Class Z: NVPAX

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A: NAHAX

   Class B: NHYBX    Class C: NYICX    Class Z: NYPAX

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A: NIVLX

   Class B: NBIVX    Class C: NVICX    Class I: —  

Class R: CIVRX

   Class Z: EMIEX      

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class A: NSGAX

   Class B: NSIBX    Class C: NSGCX    Class I: —  

Class W: CLCWX

   Class Z: NSEPX      

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class A: NMIAX

   Class R: CCERX    Class I: —      Class Y: CECYX

Class Z: NMIMX

        

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A: NEIAX

   Class B: CLIBX    Class Z: NINDX   

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class A: NVLEX

   Class B: NVLNX    Class C: NVALX    Class I: —  

Class R: CVURX

   Class W: CLVWX    Class Y: CLCYX    Class Z: NVLUX

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class A: NBIAX

   Class B: NLBBX    Class C: NBICX    Class R: CLBRX

Class Z: NBGPX

        

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class A: NLGIX

   Class B: NLGBX    Class C: NLGCX    Class R: CLGRX

Class Z: NGPAX

        

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

Class A: NLGAX

   Class B: NLIBX    Class C: NIICX    Class R: CLIRX

Class Z: NIPAX

        

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class A: NLFAX

   Class B: NLOBX    Class C: NLFCX    Class Z: CLGZX

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class A: NMTAX

   Class B: NMTBX    Class C: NMYCX    Class R: CMTRX

Class Z: NMYAX

        

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class A: NFEAX

   Class B: NFEBX    Class C: NFECX    Class I: —  

Class Z: NFEPX

        

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class A: COGAX

   Class C: COGCX    Class R: COGRX    Class Z: COGZX


Table of Contents

Fund

              

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A: NMGIX

   Class B: NGIBX    Class C: NMICX    Class I: —  

Class R: CMWRX

   Class W: CMSWX    Class Z: NGIPX   

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class A: MAIOX

   Class B: MBIOX    Class C: MCIOX    Class I: —  

Class R: CMORX

   Class Z: NMOAX      

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NMDMX

   Class B: NMITX    Class C: NMINX    Class Z: NMDBX

Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Class A: CMTAX

   Class B: CMTBX    Class C: CMTCX    Class R: CMERX

Class Z: CMTZX

        

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A: NTIAX

   Class R: —      Class Z: NMPAX   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class A: CMUAX

   Class B: CMUBX    Class C: CMUCX    Class I: —  

Class R: CMVRX

   Class R4*: —      Class W: CMUWX    Class Y: CMVYX

Class Z: NAMAX

        

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Class A: NIIAX

   Class B: NIENX    Class C: NITRX    Class I: —  

Class R: CIERX

   Class R4*: —      Class W: CMAWX    Class Z: NEIQX

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NNCIX

   Class B: NNITX    Class C: NNINX    Class Z: NNIBX

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Class A: ––

   Class C: —      Class R: —      Class Z: COSZX

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class A: NSTRX

   Class B: NSTFX    Class C: NSTIX    Class I: ––

Class R: CSBRX

   Class R4*: —      Class W: CSBWX    Class Y: CSBYX

Class Z: NSTMX

        

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NSMMX

   Class B: NSMNX    Class C: NSMUX    Class Z: NSMIX

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class A: NSCGX

   Class B: NCPBX    Class C: NCPCX    Class Z: PSCPX

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A: NMSAX

   Class Z: NMSCX      

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class A: COVAX

   Class B: COVBX    Class C: COVCX    Class I: —  

Class R: CCTRX

   Class Z: NSVAX      

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NSCIX

   Class B: NISCX    Class C: NSICX    Class Z: NSCMX

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class A: NSFAX

   Class B: NSFNX    Class C: NSFCX    Class Z: NSFIX

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Class A: NVAFX

   Class B: NVANX    Class C: NVRCX    Class Z: NVABX

Columbia Corporate Bond Portfolio

Shares: NCOBX

        

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Shares: NMTGX

        


Table of Contents

 

This Statement of Additional Information (SAI) is not a prospectus, is not a substitute for reading any prospectus and is intended to be read in conjunction with a Fund’s current prospectus. Share classes marked with an “*” have not yet commenced operations as of the date of this SAI. The most recent annual report for each Fund, which includes the Fund’s audited financial statements for its most recent fiscal period, are incorporated by reference into this SAI.

Copies of the Funds’ current prospectuses and annual and semi-annual reports may be obtained without charge by writing Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, by calling Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or by visiting the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com.

 

 

 

 

C-6518 A (9/10)


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

SAI PRIMER

     1   

ABOUT THE TRUST

     6   

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

     8   

Certain Investment Activity Limits

     8   

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     8   

Exemptive Orders

     11   

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

     12   

Borrowings

     53   

Short Sales

     53   

Lending Securities

     55   

Portfolio Turnover

     55   

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

     56   

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

     61   

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

     61   

The Subadvisers and Investment Subadvisory Services

     84   

The Administrator

     98   

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

     102   

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

     106   

Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

     113   

Other Services Provided

     117   

Distribution and Servicing Plans

     119   

Expense Limitations

     125   

Codes of Ethics

     127   

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

     128   

Expenses Paid by Third Parties

     128   

FUND GOVERNANCE

     130   

The Board

     130   

The Officers

     143   

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

     149   

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

     149   

Brokerage Commissions

     151   

Directed Brokerage

     154   

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

     155   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

     158   

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

     160   

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

     163   

Description of the Trust’s Shares

     163   

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

     167   

Purchase and Redemption

     167   

Offering Price

     170   

TAXATION

     172   

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

     190   

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     237   

APPENDIX A — DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

     A-1   

APPENDIX B — PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

     B-1   

APPENDIX C — SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

     C-1   

APPENDIX D — DESCRIPTION OF STATE CONDITIONS

     D-1   

APPENDIX E — LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

     E-1   

APPENDIX F — LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

     F-1   


Table of Contents

 

SAI PRIMER

The SAI is a part of the Funds’ registration statement that is filed with the SEC. The registration statement includes the Funds’ prospectuses, the SAI and certain exhibits. The SAI, and any supplements to it, can be found online at www.columbiamanagement.com, or by accessing the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

The SAI generally provides additional information about the Funds that is not required to be in the Funds’ prospectuses. The SAI expands discussions of certain matters described in the Funds’ prospectuses and provides certain additional information about the Funds that may be of interest to some investors. Among other things, the SAI provides information about:

 

   

the organization of the Trust;

 

   

the Funds’ investments;

 

   

the Funds’ investment adviser, investment subadviser(s) (if any) and other service providers, including roles and relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and conflicts of interest;

 

   

the governance of the Funds;

 

   

the Funds’ brokerage practices;

 

   

the share classes offered by the Funds;

 

   

the purchase, redemption and pricing of Fund shares; and

 

   

the application of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Investors may find this information important and helpful. If you have any questions about the Funds, please call Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or contact your financial advisor.

Before reading the SAI, you should consult the Glossary below, which defines certain of the terms used in the SAI.

Glossary

 

1933 Act

   Securities Act of 1933, as amended

1934 Act

   Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended

1940 Act

   Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended

Administrative Services Agreement

   The administrative services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Administrator

Administrator

   Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC

Adviser

   Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC

Ameriprise Financial

   Ameriprise Financial, Inc.

Asset Allocation Fund II

   Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

BANA

   Bank of America, National Association

Bank of America

   Bank of America Corporation

BFDS/DST

   Boston Financial Data Services, Inc./DST Systems, Inc.

Board

   The Trust’s Board of Trustees

Brandes

   Brandes Investment Partners, L.P.

 

1


Table of Contents
California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

CMOs

   Collateralized mortgage obligations

Code

   Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended

Codes of Ethics

   The codes of ethics adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act

Columbia Funds Complex

   The mutual fund complex that is comprised of the open-end investment management companies advised by the Adviser or its affiliates and principally underwritten by Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., including funds using the RiverSource, Threadneedle and Seligman brands and funds using the Columbia brand
Columbia Funds or Columbia Funds Family    The funds within the Columbia Funds Complex using the Columbia brand

Convertible Securities Fund

   Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Custodian or State Street

   State Street Bank and Trust Company

Distribution Agreement

   The distribution agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Distributor

Distribution Plan(s)

   One or more of the plans adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act for the distribution of the Funds’ shares

Distributor

   Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc.

FDIC

   Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation

Feeder Fund(s)

  

One or more of the series of CFST that invests all of its assets in a

corresponding Master Portfolio that is a series of Columbia Funds

Master Investment Trust, LLC (CMIT)

FHLMC

   The Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

Fitch

   Fitch, Inc.

FNMA

   Federal National Mortgage Association

The Fund(s) or a Fund

   One or more of the open-end management investment companies listed on the front cover of this SAI that are series of the Trust.
Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Global Value Fund

   Columbia Global Value Fund

GNMA

   Government National Mortgage Association

High Income Fund

   Columbia High Income Fund

Independent Trustees

   The Trustees of the Board who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds

Interested Trustee

   A Trustee of the Board who is currently treated as an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds

International Value Fund

   Columbia International Value Fund

 

2


Table of Contents
Investment Management Services Agreement    The investment management services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Adviser

Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement

   The investment subadvisory agreement among the Trust on behalf of the Fund(s), the Adviser and a Fund’s investment subadviser(s), as the context may require

IRS

   United States Internal Revenue Service

Large Cap Core Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Large Cap Index Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Large Cap Value Fund

   Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio
LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

LifeGoal® Portfolios

   Each of LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio and LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

LIBOR

   London Interbank Offered Rate

MacKay Shields

   MacKay Shields LLC, the investment subadviser to High Income Fund

Marsico

   Marsico Capital Management, LLC

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Marsico Global Fund

   Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Marsico Growth Fund

   Columbia Marsico Growth Fund
Marsico International Opportunities Fund    Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund
Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Mid Cap Index Fund

   Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

   Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Moody’s

   Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.
Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

NASDAQ

   National Association of Securities Dealers Automated Quotations system

 

3


Table of Contents
North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

NRSRO

   Nationally recognized statistical ratings organization (such as Moody’s, Fitch or S&P)

NSCC

   National Securities Clearing Corporation

NYSE

   New York Stock Exchange

Overseas Value Fund

   Columbia Overseas Value Fund

The Portfolio(s) or a Portfolio

  

One or more of the open-end management investment companies

listed on the front cover of this SAI that are series of the Trust

Previous Administrator

   Columbia Management Advisors, LLC

Previous Adviser

   Columbia Management Advisors, LLC

Previous Distributor

   Columbia Management Distributors, Inc.

Previous Transfer Agent

   Columbia Management Services, Inc.

REIT

   Real estate investment trust

REMIC

   Real estate mortgage investment conduit

RIC

   A “regulated investment company,” as such term is used in the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended

S&P

   Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“Standard & Poor’s” and “S&P” are trademarks of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. and have been licensed for use by the Adviser. The Columbia Funds are not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by Standard & Poor’s and Standard & Poor’s makes no representation regarding the advisability of investing in the Columbia Funds).

SAI

   This Statement of Additional Information

SEC

   United States Securities and Exchange Commission

Selling Agent(s)

   One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a sales support agreement with the Distributor

Servicing Agent(s)

   One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a shareholder servicing agreement with the Distributor

Short Term Bond Fund

   Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Small Cap Index Fund

   Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Small Cap Value Fund II

   Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II
South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Total Return Bond Fund

   Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

 

4


Table of Contents

Transfer Agency Agreement

   The transfer agency agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.

Transfer Agent

   Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.

The Trust

   Columbia Funds Series Trust, the registered investment company in the Columbia Funds Family to which this SAI relates

Trustee(s)

   One or more of the Board’s Trustees
Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

 

5


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE TRUST

The Trust is a registered investment company under the 1940 Act within the Columbia Funds Family. Columbia Funds currently include more than 100 mutual funds in major asset classes, and the Adviser had approximately $301.8 billion assets under management as of June 30, 2010.

The Trust was organized as a Delaware business trust, a form of entity now known as a statutory trust, on October 22, 1999. On September 26, 2005, the Trust changed its name from Nations Funds Trust to Columbia Funds Series Trust.

Funds and portfolios that bore the “Columbia” and “Columbia Acorn” brands prior to September 27, 2010 are collectively referred to herein as the Legacy Columbia funds. For a list of Legacy Columbia funds, see Appendix E. Funds and portfolios that historically bore the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle brands, including those renamed to bear the “Columbia” brand effective September 27, 2010, as well as certain other funds are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds. For a list of Legacy RiverSource funds, see Appendix F.

Funds with a fiscal year end of February 28

On or about September 26, 2005, the names of certain of the Funds were changed as follows: Nations Convertible Securities Fund to Columbia Convertible Securities Fund, Nations Value Fund to Columbia Large Cap Value Fund, Nations Marsico 21st Century Fund to Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund, Nations MidCap Value Fund to Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund, Nations SmallCap Value Fund to Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II, Nations Strategic Growth Fund to Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Nations Marsico Focused Equities Fund to Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Nations Marsico Growth Fund to Columbia Marsico Growth Fund, Nations Small Company Fund to Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II, Nations Global Value Fund to Columbia Global Value Fund, Nations Marsico International Opportunities Fund to Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Nations International Equity Fund to Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, Nations International Value Fund to Columbia International Value Fund, Nations LargeCap Index Fund to Columbia Large Cap Index Fund, Nations MidCap Index Fund to Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund, Nations SmallCap Index Fund to Columbia Small Cap Index Fund and Nations LargeCap Enhanced Core Fund to Nations Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund.

On February 28, 2008, each of Large Cap Core Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Small Cap Growth Fund II converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund. On November 10, 2008, Marsico Growth Fund converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund.

Prior to August 2006, Convertible Securities Fund, Global Value Fund, Large Cap Value Fund, Marsico 21st Century Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, Mid Cap Value Fund, Small Cap Value Fund II, Large Cap Index Fund, Mid Cap Index Fund, Small Cap Index Fund, Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund each had a fiscal year end of March 31.

Prior to October 2007, International Value Fund, Large Cap Core Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Marsico Growth Fund and Small Cap Growth Fund II each had a fiscal year end of March 31.

International Value Fund is a Feeder Fund that seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing substantially all of its assets in another mutual fund (the Master Portfolio) with the same investment objective, principal investment strategies and investment risks. The Master Portfolio is a separate series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. As of March 30, 2007, Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC converted from a Delaware statutory trust to a Delaware limited liability company. Remember that the terms “Fund” and “Master Portfolio” are sometimes used interchangeably in this SAI.

 

6


Table of Contents

 

Each of the Funds represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end management investment company. Each of the Funds is diversified, except Marsico Focused Equities Fund. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of February 28. For more information on the classes of shares offered by the Funds, see Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Funds with a fiscal year end of March 31

On September 26, 2005, the names of certain of the Funds were changed as follows: Asset Allocation Fund to Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II, Nations California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Nations Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund to Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Short-Term Income Fund to Columbia Short Term Bond Fund, Nations Short-Term Municipal Income Fund to Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund, Nations Bond Fund to Columbia Total Return Bond Fund, Nations High Yield Bond Fund to Columbia High Income Fund, Nations LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, Nations LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, Nations LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio and Nations LifeGoal® Income Portfolio to Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio.

On February 28, 2008, High Income Fund converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund.

Each of the LifeGoal® Portfolios is a “fund of funds” that invests its assets in a mix of Underlying Funds using an asset allocation approach.

Masters International Equity Portfolio was first offered as a series of the Trust on February 15, 2006. The Portfolio is a “fund of funds” that invests its assets in a mix of Underlying Funds using an asset allocation approach.

Each of the Funds represents a separate series of the Trust and, except for the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of March 31. For more information on the classes of shares offered by the Funds, see Capital Stock and Other Securities.

 

7


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

The investment objectives, principal investment strategies (i.e., as used in this SAI and the corresponding prospectuses, a strategy which generally involves the ability to invest 10% or more of a Fund’s total assets) and related principal risks for each Fund are discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Certain Investment Activity Limits

The overall investment and other activities of the Adviser and its affiliates may limit the investment opportunities for each Fund in certain markets where limitations are imposed by regulators upon the amount of investment by affiliated investors, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. From time to time, each Fund’s activities also may be restricted because of regulatory restrictions applicable to the Adviser and its affiliates and/or because of their internal policies. See Investment Advisory and Other Services — Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates — Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

The following discussion of “fundamental” and “non-fundamental” investment policies and limitations for each Fund supplements the discussion of investment policies in the Funds’ prospectuses. A fundamental policy may be changed only with Board and shareholder approval. A non-fundamental policy may be changed by the Board and does not require shareholder approval, but may require notice to shareholders in certain instances.

Unless otherwise noted, whenever an investment policy or limitation states a maximum percentage of a Fund’s assets that may be invested in any security or other asset, or sets forth a policy regarding an investment standard, compliance with such percentage limitation or standard will be determined solely at the time of the Fund’s acquisition of such security or asset. Borrowings and other instruments that may give rise to leverage and the restriction on investing in illiquid securities are monitored on an ongoing basis.

Fundamental Investment Policies

The 1940 Act provides that a “vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities” means the affirmative vote of the lesser of (1) more than 50% of the outstanding shares of a Fund, or (2) 67% or more of the shares present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding shares are represented at the meeting in person or by proxy. The following fundamental investment policies cannot be changed without such a vote.

Overseas Value Fund may not, as a matter of fundamental policy:

 

  1. Underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies;

 

  2. Purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein;

 

  3. Purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts;

 

8


Table of Contents

 

  4. Purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief;

 

  5. Make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief;

 

  6. Borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief; and

 

  7. Purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief obtained by the Fund.

Each Fund other than Overseas Value Fund may not, as a matter of fundamental policy:

 

  1. Underwrite any issue of securities within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might technically be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with its investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered management investment companies;

 

  2. Purchase or sell real estate, except the Fund may purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate and may purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate;

 

  3. Purchase or sell commodities, except that the Fund may, to the extent consistent with its investment objective, invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, and purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions, including, without limitation, forward currency contracts;

 

  4. Purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States, or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds;

 

  5. Make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds;

 

  6. Borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds; and

 

  7.

Except Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the

 

9


Table of Contents
 

securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds.

As a matter of fundamental policy, under normal circumstances, California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund, each will invest at least 80% of its assets in securities that pay interest exempt from federal income tax, other than the federal alternative minimum tax, and state individual income tax.

As a matter of fundamental policy, under normal circumstances, Short Term Municipal Bond Fund will invest at least 80% of its assets in securities that pay interest exempt from federal income tax, other than the federal alternative minimum tax.

Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

 

Fund

   May Not Invest
more than 15%
of its net assets
in illiquid
securities(a)
     May not sell
securities
short(b)
     May not
purchase
securities of
other investment
companies(c)
     Provides 60
day notice in
connection with
Rule 35d-1
changes(d)
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

   ü         ü         ü        

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Convertible Securities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Global Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

High Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

International Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Large Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü        

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico Global Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico Growth Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mid Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mid Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Overseas Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

 

10


Table of Contents

Fund

   May Not Invest
more than 15%
of its net assets
in illiquid
securities(a)
     May not sell
securities
short(b)
     May not
purchase
securities of
other investment
companies(c)
     Provides 60
day notice in
connection with
Rule 35d-1
changes(d)
 

Short Term Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Small Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Small Cap Value Fund II

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

Total Return Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü     

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü        

 

a

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, invest more than 15% of their net assets in illiquid securities. “Illiquid Securities” is defined in accordance with the SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is a security which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which the fund has valued the security.

b

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

c

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of one of these Funds are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.

d

To the extent a Fund with a check mark in this column is subject to Rule 35d-1 under the 1940 Act (the Names Rule), and does not otherwise have a fundamental investment policy in place to comply with the Names Rule, such Fund has adopted the following non-fundamental policy: Shareholders will receive at least 60 days’ notice of any change to the Fund’s investment objective or principal investment strategies made in order to comply with the Names Rule. The notice will be provided in plain English in a separate written document, and will contain the following prominent statement or similar statement in bold-face type: “Important Notice Regarding Change in Investment Policy.” This statement will appear on both the notice and the envelope in which it is delivered, unless it is delivered separately from other communications to investors, in which case the statement will appear either on the notice or the envelope in which the notice is delivered.

Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund may not purchase securities of any one issuer (other than U.S. Government Obligations and securities of other investment companies) if, immediately after such purchase, more than 25% of the value of the Funds total assets would be invested in the securities of one issuer, and with respect to 50% of the Fund’s total assets, more than 5% of its assets would be invested in the securities of one issuer.

Exemptive Orders

In addition to the policies outlined above, the Columbia Funds Family has received the following exemptive orders from the SEC which enable the Fund to participate in certain transactions beyond the investment limitations described above or described in otherwise applicable restrictions:

 

  1.

Pursuant to an exemptive order dated October 5, 1993, all current and future Funds advised by the Adviser may, subject to certain conditions, pool their uninvested cash balances in one or more joint

 

11


Table of Contents
 

accounts and use the daily balance of such accounts to enter into repurchase agreements, including the condition that such agreements have a maturity of not more than seven days.

 

  2. Pursuant to an exemptive order dated September 5, 2003, the Fund may, subject to certain conditions, borrow money from other Funds in the Columbia Funds Family for temporary emergency purposes in order to facilitate redemption requests, or for other purposes consistent with Fund investment policies and restrictions. All loans are set at an interest rate between the rates charged on overnight repurchase agreements and short-term bank loans.

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

Each Fund’s prospectuses identify and summarize the individual types of securities in which the Fund invests as part of its principal investment strategies and the principal risks associated with such investments.

The table below identifies certain types of securities in which each Fund is permitted to invest, including certain types of securities that are described in each Fund’s prospectuses. A Fund generally has the ability to invest 10% or more of its total assets in each type of security described in its prospectuses (and in each sub-category of such security type described in this SAI). To the extent that a type of security identified below for a Fund is not described in the Fund’s prospectuses (or as a sub-category of such security type in this SAI), the Fund generally invests less than 10% of the Fund’s total assets in such security type.

Information about individual types of securities (including certain of their associated risks) in which some or all of the Funds may invest is set forth below. Each Fund’s investment in these types of securities is subject to its investment objective and fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies.

Temporary Defensive Positions. Each Fund may temporarily invest in money market instruments or hold cash. It may do so without limit, when the Adviser or the Fund’s subadviser, if applicable: (i) believes that the market conditions are not favorable for profitable investing; (ii) is unable to locate favorable investment opportunities; or (iii) determines that a temporary defensive position is advisable or necessary in order to meet anticipated redemption requests, or for other reasons. While a Fund engages in such strategies, it may not achieve its investment objective. See also About the Funds’ Investments — Permissible Investments and Related Risks — Money Market Instruments.

Permissible Fund Investments

 

Investment Type

   Asset
Allocation
Fund II
    California
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Convertible
Securities
Fund
    Corporate
Bond
Portfolio
    Georgia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Global
Value
Fund
    High
Income
Fund
    International
Value Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

                

Domestic

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

   ü                   

 

12


Table of Contents

Investment Type

   Asset
Allocation
Fund II
    California
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Convertible
Securities
Fund
    Corporate
Bond
Portfolio
    Georgia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Global
Value
Fund
    High
Income
Fund
    International
Value Fund
 

Derivatives

                

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

       ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

                 ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Municipal Securities

   ü        ü          ü        ü           

Participation Interests

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Standby Commitments

   ü                   

Stripped Securities

   ü          ü        ü          ü          ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

13


Table of Contents

Investment Type

   Asset
Allocation
Fund II
    California
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Convertible
Securities
Fund
    Corporate
Bond
Portfolio
    Georgia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Global
Value
Fund
    High
Income
Fund
    International
Value Fund
 

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Warrants and Rights

   ü          ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

   ü          ü        ü          ü          ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

   ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

  Large Cap
Core Fund
    Large Cap
Enhanced

Core  Fund
    Large Cap
Index Fund
    Large Cap
Value
Fund
    LifeGoal®
Balanced
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income

and Growth
Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income
Portfolio
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

               

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

Derivatives

               

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü          ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

14


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Large Cap
Core Fund
    Large Cap
Enhanced

Core  Fund
    Large Cap
Index Fund
    Large Cap
Value
Fund
    LifeGoal®
Balanced
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Growth

Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income

and Growth
Portfolio
    LifeGoal®
Income
Portfolio
 

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

          ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

  Marsico  21st
Century
Fund
    Marsico
Focused
Equities Fund
    Marsico
Global Fund
    Marsico
Growth Fund
    Marsico
International
Opportunities
Fund
    Maryland
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Masters
International
Equity
Portfolio
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

             

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

              ü     

 

15


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Marsico  21st
Century
Fund
    Marsico
Focused
Equities Fund
    Marsico
Global Fund
    Marsico
Growth Fund
    Marsico
International
Opportunities
Fund
    Maryland
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Masters
International
Equity
Portfolio
 

Derivatives

             

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

             

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

      ü            ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

16


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Marsico  21st
Century
Fund
    Marsico
Focused
Equities Fund
    Marsico
Global Fund
    Marsico
Growth Fund
    Marsico
International
Opportunities
Fund
    Maryland
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Masters
International
Equity
Portfolio
 

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

      ü              ü     

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

  Mid
Cap
Index
Fund
    Mid
Cap
Value
Fund
    Mortgage-
and Asset-
Backed
Portfolio
    Multi-Advisor
International
Equity Fund
    North
Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Overseas
Value
Fund
    Short
Term
Bond Fund
    Short Term
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

               

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

               

Derivatives

               

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü       

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

17


Table of Contents

Investment Type

  Mid
Cap
Index
Fund
    Mid
Cap
Value
Fund
    Mortgage-
and Asset-
Backed
Portfolio
    Multi-Advisor
International
Equity Fund
    North
Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
    Overseas
Value
Fund
    Short
Term
Bond Fund
    Short Term
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

    ü        ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Investing in a Master Portfolio

               

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

      ü          ü          ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

               

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü            ü        ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü        ü     

 

Investment Type

   Small Cap
Growth
Fund II
     Small Cap
Index Fund
     Small Cap
Value

Fund II
     South Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal

Bond Fund
     Total
Return
Bond Fund
     Virginia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Bank Obligations

                 

Domestic

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Common Stock

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Convertible Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

 

18


Table of Contents

Investment Type

   Small Cap
Growth
Fund II
     Small Cap
Index Fund
     Small Cap
Value

Fund II
     South Carolina
Intermediate
Municipal

Bond Fund
     Total
Return
Bond Fund
     Virginia
Intermediate
Municipal
Bond Fund
 

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

                 

Derivatives

                 

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Swap Agreements

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Dollar Rolls

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Illiquid Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Initial Public Offerings

   ü            ü            ü        

Investing in a Master Portfolio

                 

Investments in Other Investment Companies

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Money Market Instruments

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Municipal Securities

            ü         ü         ü     

Participation Interests

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Preferred Stock

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Repurchase Agreements

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Standby Commitments

                 

Stripped Securities

   ü         ü         ü            ü        

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Warrants and Rights

   ü         ü         ü            ü        

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

   ü         ü         ü            ü        

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

 

19


Table of Contents

 

Asset-Backed Securities

Asset-backed securities represent interests in, or debt instruments that are backed by, pools of various types of assets that generate cash payments generally over fixed periods of time. Such securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying assets (less fees paid to the originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying assets effectively pass through to such security holders. Asset-backed securities typically are created by an originator of loans or owner of accounts receivable that sells such underlying assets to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying assets, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Asset-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in asset-backed securities is subject to certain risks. For example, the value of asset-backed securities may be affected by, among other factors, changes in: interest rates, the market’s assessment of the quality of underlying assets, the creditworthiness of the servicer for the underlying assets, information concerning the originator of the underlying assets, or the creditworthiness or rating of the entities that provide any supporting letters of credit, surety bonds, derivative instruments, or other credit enhancement. The value of asset-backed securities also will be affected by the exhaustion, termination or expiration of any credit enhancement.

Declining or low interest rates may lead to a more rapid rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in accelerated payments on asset-backed securities that then would be reinvested at a lesser rate of interest. Rising or high interest rates tend to lead to a slower rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in slower than expected payments on asset-backed securities that can, in turn, lead to a decline in value. The impact of changing interest rates on the value of asset-backed securities may be difficult to predict and result in greater volatility. Holders of asset-backed securities generally have no recourse against the originator of the underlying assets in the event of a default on the underlying assets. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of asset-backed securities, backed by pools of receivables such as mortgage loans, may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or an underlying obligor has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for asset-backed securities that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of an asset-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be.

Bank Obligations (Domestic and Foreign)

Bank obligations include certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances, time deposits and promissory notes that earn a specified rate of return and may be issued by (i) a domestic branch of a domestic bank, (ii) a foreign branch of a domestic bank, (iii) a domestic branch of a foreign bank or (iv) a foreign branch of a foreign bank. Bank obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

Certificates of deposit, or so-called CDs, typically are interest-bearing debt instruments issued by banks and have maturities ranging from a few weeks to several years. Bankers’ acceptances are time drafts drawn on and accepted by banks, are a customary means of effecting payment for merchandise sold in import-export transactions and are a general source of financing. Yankee dollar certificates of deposit are negotiable CDs issued in the United States by branches and agencies of foreign banks. Eurodollar certificates of deposit are CDs issued by foreign (mainly European) banks with interest and principal paid in U.S. dollars. Such CDs typically have maturities of less than two years and have interest rates that typically are pegged to the London Interbank Offered

 

20


Table of Contents

Rate or LIBOR. A time deposit can be either a savings account or CD that is an obligation of a financial institution for a fixed term. Typically, there are penalties for early withdrawals of time deposits. Promissory notes are written commitments of the maker to pay the payee a specified sum of money either on demand or at a fixed or determinable future date, with or without interest.

Bank investment contracts are issued by banks. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of a bank. The bank then credits to the Fund payments at floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund also may hold funds on deposit with its custodian for temporary purposes.

Investing in bank obligations is subject to certain risks. Certain bank obligations, such as some CDs, are insured by the FDIC up to certain specified limits. Many other bank obligations, however, are neither guaranteed nor insured by the FDIC or the U.S. Government. These bank obligations are “backed” only by the creditworthiness of the issuing bank or parent financial institution. Domestic and foreign banks are subject to different governmental regulation. Accordingly, certain obligations of foreign banks, including Eurodollar and Yankee dollar obligations, involve different investment risks than those affecting obligations of domestic banks, including, among others, the possibilities that: (i) their liquidity could be impaired because of political or economic developments; (ii) the obligations may be less marketable than comparable obligations of domestic banks; (iii) a foreign jurisdiction might impose withholding and other taxes at high levels on interest income; (iv) foreign deposits may be seized or nationalized; (v) foreign governmental restrictions such as exchange controls may be imposed, which could adversely affect the payment of principal or interest on those obligations; (vi) there may be less publicly available information concerning foreign banks issuing the obligations; and (vii) the reserve requirements and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards, practices and requirements applicable to foreign banks may differ from those applicable to domestic banks. Foreign banks generally are not subject to examination by any U.S. Government agency or instrumentality.

Common Stock

Common stock represents a unit of equity ownership of a corporation. Owners typically are entitled to vote on the selection of directors and other important corporate governance matters, and to receive dividend payments, if any, on their holdings. However, ownership of common stock does not entitle owners to participate in the day-to-day operations of the corporation. Common stocks of domestic and foreign public corporations can be listed, and their shares traded, on domestic stock exchanges, such as the NYSE or the NASDAQ Stock Market. Domestic and foreign corporations also may have their shares traded on foreign exchanges, such as the London Stock Exchange or Tokyo Stock Exchange. Common stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in common stocks is subject to certain risks. Stock market risk, for example, is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods of time, perhaps substantially or unexpectedly. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when stock prices generally rise and periods when stock prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and fall based on factors specific to each company, such as changes in earnings or management, as well as general economic and market factors.

If a corporation is liquidated, the claims of secured and unsecured creditors and owners of debt securities and “preferred” stock take priority over the claims of those who own common stock.

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to the particular type of company issuing the common stock. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price swings than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, may be more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Common stocks of these types of companies may have a higher potential for gains, but also may be subject to greater risk of loss.

 

21


Table of Contents

 

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of common stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably affect, an industry, the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry to decline quickly.

Convertible Securities

Convertible securities include bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks or other securities that may be converted or exchanged (by the holder or by the issuer) into shares of the underlying common stock (or cash or securities of equivalent value) at a stated exchange ratio or predetermined price (the conversion price). As such, convertible securities combine the investment characteristics of debt securities and equity securities. A holder of convertible securities is entitled to receive the income of a bond, debenture or note or the dividend of a preferred stock until the conversion privilege is exercised. The market value of convertible securities generally is a function of, among other factors, interest rates, the rates of return of similar nonconvertible securities and the financial strength of the issuer. The market value of convertible securities tends to decline as interest rates rise and, conversely, to rise as interest rates decline. However, a convertible security’s market value tends to reflect the market price of the common stock of the issuing company when that stock price approaches or is greater than its conversion price. As the market price of the underlying common stock declines, the price of the convertible security tends to be influenced more by the rate of return of the convertible security. Because both interest rate and market movements can influence their value, convertible securities generally are not as sensitive to changes in interest rates as similar debt securities nor generally are they as sensitive to changes in share price as their underlying common stock. Convertible securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in convertible securities is subject to certain risks. Certain convertible securities, particularly securities that are convertible into securities of an issuer other than the issuer of the convertible security, may be illiquid and, therefore, may be more difficult to resell in a timely fashion or for a fair price, which could result in investment losses. Certain convertible securities may have a mandatory conversion feature, pursuant to which the securities convert automatically into common stock or other equity securities (of the same or a different issuer) at a specified date and a specified exchange ratio. Certain convertible securities may be convertible at the option of the issuer, which may require a holder to convert the security into the underlying common stock, even at times when the value of the underlying common stock or other equity security has declined substantially. In addition, some convertible securities may be rated below investment grade or may not be rated and, therefore, may be considered speculative investments. Companies that issue convertible securities frequently are small- and mid-capitalization companies and, accordingly, carry the risks associated with such companies. In addition, the credit rating of a company’s convertible securities generally is lower than that of its conventional debt securities. Convertible securities are senior to equity securities and have a claim to the assets of an issuer prior to the holders of the issuer’s common stock in the event of liquidation but generally are subordinate to similar non-convertible debt securities of the same issuer. Some convertible securities are particularly sensitive to changes in interest rates when their predetermined conversion price is much higher than the price for the issuing company’s common stock.

Corporate Debt Securities

Corporate debt securities are fixed income securities typically issued by businesses to finance their operations. Notes, bonds, debentures and commercial paper are the most common types of corporate debt securities, with the primary difference being their interest rates, maturity dates and secured or unsecured status.

 

22


Table of Contents

Commercial paper has the shortest term and usually is unsecured. The broad category of corporate debt securities includes debt issued by domestic or foreign companies of all kinds, including those with small-, mid- and large-capitalizations. The category also includes bank loans, as well as assignments, participations and other interests in bank loans. Corporate debt securities may be rated investment grade or below investment grade and may be structured as fixed-, variable or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Extendible commercial notes (ECNs) are very similar to commercial paper except that with ECNs, the issuer has the option to extend the notes’ maturity. ECNs are issued at a discount rate, with an initial redemption of not more than 90 days from the date of issue. If ECNs are not redeemed by the issuer on the initial redemption date, the issuer will pay a premium (step-up) rate based on the ECN’s credit rating at the time.

Because of the wide range of types and maturities of corporate debt securities, as well as the range of creditworthiness of issuers, corporate debt securities can have widely varying risk/return profiles. For example, commercial paper issued by a large established domestic corporation that is rated by an NRSRO as investment grade may have a relatively modest return on principal but present relatively limited risk. On the other hand, a long-term corporate note issued, for example, by a small foreign corporation from an emerging market country that has not been rated by an NRSRO may have the potential for relatively large returns on principal but carries a relatively high degree of risk.

Investing in corporate debt securities is subject to certain risks including, among others, credit and interest rate risk. Credit risk is the risk that a Fund could lose money if the issuer of a corporate debt security is unable to pay interest or repay principal when it becomes due. Some corporate debt securities that are rated below investment grade by an NRSRO generally are considered speculative because they present a greater risk of loss, including default, than higher quality debt securities. The credit risk of a particular issuer’s debt security may vary based on its priority for repayment. For example, higher ranking (senior) debt securities have a higher priority than and, therefore, may be paid in full before, lower ranking (subordinated) securities. In addition, in the event of bankruptcy, holders of higher-ranking senior securities may receive amounts otherwise payable to the holders of more junior securities. Interest rate risk is the risk that the value of certain corporate debt securities will tend to fall when interest rates rise. In general, corporate debt securities with longer terms tend to fall more in value when interest rates rise than do corporate debt securities with shorter terms.

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

Custody receipts and trust certificates are derivative products that evidence direct ownership in a pool of securities. Typically, a sponsor will deposit a pool of securities with a custodian in exchange for custody receipts evidencing interests in those securities. The sponsor generally then will sell the custody receipts or trust certificates in negotiated transactions at varying prices. Each custody receipt or trust certificate evidences the individual securities in the pool and the holder of a custody receipt or trust certificate generally will have all the rights and privileges of owners of those securities.

Investing in custody receipts and trust certificates is subject to certain risks. Custody receipts and trust certificates generally are subject to the same risks as the securities evidenced by the receipts or certificates. Custody receipts and trust certificates also may be less liquid than the underlying securities.

Derivatives

General

Derivatives are financial instruments whose values are based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or a bond), assets (such as a commodity, like gold), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market

 

23


Table of Contents

indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Some forms of derivatives, such as exchange-traded futures and options on securities, commodities, or indices, are traded on regulated exchanges. These types of derivatives are standardized contracts that can easily be bought and sold, and whose market values are determined and published daily. Non-standardized derivatives, on the other hand, tend to be more specialized or complex, and may be harder to value. Derivatives afford leverage and, when used properly, can enhance returns and be useful in hedging portfolios. Some common types of derivatives include futures; options; options on futures; forward foreign currency exchange contracts; forward contracts on securities and securities indices; linked securities and structured products; CMOs; stripped securities; warrants; swap agreements and swaptions.

A Fund may use derivatives for a variety of reasons, including, for example: (i) to enhance its return; (ii) to attempt to protect against possible changes in the market value of securities held in or to be purchased for its portfolio resulting from securities markets or currency exchange rate fluctuations (i.e., to hedge); (iii) to protect its unrealized gains reflected in the value of its portfolio securities; (iv) to facilitate the sale of such securities for investment purposes; (v) to reduce transaction costs; and/or (vi) to manage the effective maturity or duration of its portfolio.

A Fund’s use of derivatives presents risks different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in traditional securities. The use of derivatives can lead to losses because of adverse movements in the price or value of the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate, which may be magnified by certain features of the derivatives. These risks are heightened when a Fund uses derivatives to enhance its return or as a substitute for a position or security, rather than solely to hedge or offset the risk of a position or security held by a Fund. There is also a risk that the derivative will not correlate well with the security for which it is substituting. A Fund’s use of derivatives to leverage risk also may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing a Fund to lose more money than if it had invested in the underlying security, or limit a potential gain. The success of management’s derivative strategies will depend on its ability to assess and predict the impact of market or economic developments on the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate and the derivative itself, without necessarily the benefit of observing the performance of the derivative under all possible market conditions. Other risks arise from a Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell its derivative positions as a liquid secondary market for such positions may not exist at times when a Fund may wish to terminate or sell them. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid. Derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. Also, with some derivative strategies there is the risk that a Fund may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to invest in derivatives altogether. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount and accelerate the timing of taxes payable by shareholders.

A Fund may use any or all of the above investment techniques and may purchase different types of derivative instruments at any time and in any combination. There is no particular strategy that dictates the use of one technique over another, as the use of derivatives is a function of numerous variables, including market conditions.

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

General. Indexed or linked securities, also often referred to as “structured products,” are instruments that may have varying combinations of equity and debt characteristics. These instruments are structured to recast the investment characteristics of the underlying security or reference asset. If the issuer is a unit investment trust or other special purpose vehicle, the structuring will typically involve the deposit with or purchase by such issuer of specified instruments (such as commercial bank loans or securities) and/or the execution of various derivative transactions, and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of securities (structured securities) backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying instruments. The cash flow on the underlying instruments may be apportioned among the newly issued structured securities to create securities with different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, payment priorities and interest rate provisions, and the extent of such payments made with respect to structured securities is dependent on the extent of the cash flow on the underlying instruments.

 

24


Table of Contents

 

Indexed and Inverse Floating Rate Securities. A Fund may invest in securities that provide a potential return based on a particular index of value or interest rates. For example, a Fund may invest in securities that pay interest based on an index of interest rates. The principal amount payable upon maturity of certain securities also may be based on the value of the index. To the extent a Fund invests in these types of securities, a Fund’s return on such securities will rise and fall with the value of the particular index: that is, if the value of the index falls, the value of the indexed securities owned by a Fund will fall. Interest and principal payable on certain securities may also be based on relative changes among particular indices.

A Fund may also invest in so-called “inverse floaters” or “residual interest bonds” on which the interest rates vary inversely with a floating rate (which may be reset periodically by a dutch auction, a remarketing agent, or by reference to a short-term tax-exempt interest rate index). A Fund may purchase synthetically-created inverse floating rate bonds evidenced by custodial or trust receipts. Generally, income on inverse floating rate bonds will decrease when interest rates increase, and will increase when interest rates decrease. Such securities have the effect of providing a degree of investment leverage, since they may increase or decrease in value in response to changes, as an illustration, in market interest rates at a rate that is a multiple of the rate at which fixed-rate securities increase or decrease in response to such changes. As a result, the market values of such securities will generally be more volatile than the market values of fixed-rate securities. To seek to limit the volatility of these securities, a Fund may purchase inverse floating obligations that have shorter-term maturities or that contain limitations on the extent to which the interest rate may vary. Certain investments in such obligations may be illiquid. A Fund may invest in indexed and inverse securities for hedging purposes or to seek to increase returns. When used for hedging purposes, indexed and inverse securities involve correlation risk. Furthermore, where such a security includes a contingent liability, in the event of an adverse movement in the underlying index or interest rate, a Fund may be required to pay substantial additional margin to maintain the position.

Credit Linked Securities. Among the income producing securities in which a Fund may invest are credit linked securities. The issuers of these securities frequently are limited purpose trusts or other special purpose vehicles that, in turn, invest in a derivative instrument or basket of derivative instruments, such as credit default swaps, interest rate swaps and other securities, in order to provide exposure to certain fixed income markets. For instance, a Fund may invest in credit linked securities as a cash management tool in order to gain exposure to a certain market and/or to remain fully invested when more traditional income producing securities are not available.

Like an investment in a bond, investments in these credit linked securities represent the right to receive periodic income payments (in the form of distributions) and payment of principal at the end of the term of the security. However, these payments are conditioned on or linked to the issuer’s receipt of payments from, and the issuer’s potential obligations to, the counterparties to the derivative instruments and other securities in which the issuer invests. For instance, the issuer may sell one or more credit default swaps, under which the issuer would receive a stream of payments over the term of the swap agreements provided that no event of default has occurred with respect to the referenced debt obligation upon which the swap is based. If a default occurs, the stream of payments may stop and the issuer would be obligated to pay the counterparty the par (or other agreed upon value) of the referenced debt obligation. This, in turn, would reduce the amount of income and/or principal that a Fund would receive. A Fund’s investments in these instruments are indirectly subject to the risks associated with derivative instruments, including, among others, credit risk, default or similar event risk, counterparty risk, interest rate risk, leverage risk and management risk. These securities generally are exempt from registration under the 1933 Act. Accordingly, there may be no established trading market for the securities and they may constitute illiquid investments.

Index-, Commodity-, Currency- and Equity-Linked Securities. “Index-linked” or “commodity-linked” notes are debt securities of companies that call for interest payments and/or payment at maturity in different terms than the typical note where the borrower agrees to make fixed interest payments and to pay a fixed sum at maturity. Principal and/or interest payments on an index-linked or commodity-linked note depend on the performance of

 

25


Table of Contents

one or more market indices, such as the S&P 500® Index, a weighted index of commodity futures such as crude oil, gasoline and natural gas or the market prices of a particular commodity or basket of commodities. Equity-linked securities are short-term or intermediate term instruments having a value at maturity and/or interest rate determined by reference to the market prices of one or more equity securities. At maturity, the principal amount of an equity-linked debt security is often exchanged for common stock of the issuer or is payable in an amount based on the issuer’s common stock price at the time of maturity. Currency-linked debt securities are short-term or intermediate-term instruments having a value at maturity, and/or an interest rate, determined by reference to one or more foreign currencies. Payment of principal or periodic interest may be calculated as a multiple of the movement of one currency against another currency, or against an index.

Index, commodity, currency and equity-linked securities may entail substantial risks. Such instruments may be subject to significant price volatility. The company issuing the instrument may fail to pay the amount due on maturity. The underlying investment or security may not perform as expected by the Adviser. Markets, underlying securities and indexes may move in a direction that was not anticipated by the Adviser. Performance of the derivatives may be influenced by interest rate and other market changes in the United States and abroad, and certain derivative instruments may be illiquid.

Linked securities are often issued by unit investment trusts. Examples of this include such index-linked securities as S&P Depositary Receipts (SPDRs), which is an interest in a unit investment trust holding a portfolio of securities linked to the S&P 500® Index, and a type of exchange-traded fund (ETF). Because a unit investment trust is an investment company under the 1940 Act, a Fund’s investments in SPDRs are subject to the limitations set forth in Section 12(d)(1)(A) of the 1940 Act. SPDRs closely track the underlying portfolio of securities, trade like a share of common stock and pay periodic dividends proportionate to those paid by the portfolio of stocks that comprise the S&P 500® Index. As a holder of interests in a unit investment trust, a Fund would indirectly bear its ratable share of that unit investment trust’s expenses. At the same time, a Fund would continue to pay its own management and advisory fees and other expenses, as a result of which a Fund and its shareholders in effect would be absorbing levels of fees with respect to investments in such unit investment trusts.

Equity-linked securities include issues such as Structured Yield Product Exchangeable for Stock (STRYPES), Trust Automatic Common Exchange Securities (TRACES), Trust Issued Mandatory Exchange Securities (TIMES), and Trust Enhanced Dividend Securities (TRENDS). The issuers of these equity-linked securities generally purchase and hold a portfolio of stripped U.S. Treasury securities maturing on a quarterly basis through the conversion date, and a forward purchase contract with an existing shareholder of the company relating to the common stock. Quarterly distributions on such equity-linked securities generally consist of the cash received from the U.S. Treasury securities and such equity-linked securities generally are not entitled to any dividends that may be declared on the common stock.

Investing in structured products and linked securities is subject to certain risks. Because structured products typically involve no credit enhancement, their credit risk generally will be equivalent to that of the underlying instruments. Investments in structured products may be structured as a class that is either subordinated or unsubordinated to the right of payment of another class. Subordinated structured products typically have higher rates of return and present greater risks than unsubordinated structured products. Structured products sometimes are sold in private placement transactions and often have a limited trading market.

Investments in “linked” securities have the potential to lead to significant losses because of unexpected movements in the underlying financial asset, index, currency or other investment. The ability of a Fund to utilize linked-securities successfully will depend on its ability correctly to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. Because currency-linked securities usually relate to foreign currencies, some of which may be currencies from emerging market countries, there are certain additional risks associated with such investments.

SPDRs are subject to the risks of an investment in a broadly based portfolio of common stocks, including the risk that the general level of stock prices may decline, thereby adversely affecting the value of such

 

26


Table of Contents

investment. In addition, because individual investments in SPDRs are not redeemable, except upon termination of the unit investment trust, the liquidity of small holdings of SPDRs will depend upon the existence of a secondary market. Large holdings of SPDRs are called “creation unit size” and are redeemable in-kind only and are not redeemable for cash from the unit investment trust. The price of a SPDR is derived from and based upon the securities held by the unit investment trust. Accordingly, the level of risk involved in the purchase or sale of a SPDR is similar to the risk involved in the purchase or sale of traditional common stock, with the exception that the pricing mechanism for SPDRs is based on a basket of stocks. Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying SPDRs purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on SPDRs.

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

Futures Contracts. A futures contract sale creates an obligation by the seller to deliver the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. A futures contract purchase creates an obligation by the purchaser to take delivery of the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. The specific security or other asset delivered or taken at the settlement date is not determined until on or near that date. The determination is made in accordance with the rules of the exchange on which the futures contract was made. A Fund may enter into futures contracts which are traded on national or foreign futures exchanges and are standardized as to maturity date and underlying security or other asset. Futures exchanges and trading in the United States are regulated under the Commodity Exchange Act (CEA) by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), a U.S. Government agency.

Traders in futures contracts may be broadly classified as either “hedgers” or “speculators.” Hedgers use the futures markets primarily to offset unfavorable changes (anticipated or potential) in the value of securities or other assets currently owned or expected to be acquired by them. Speculators less often own the securities or other assets underlying the futures contracts which they trade, and generally use futures contracts with the expectation of realizing profits from fluctuations in the value of the underlying securities or other assets. Pursuant to a notice of eligibility claiming exclusion from the definition of commodity pool operator filed with the CFTC and the National Futures Association on behalf of the Funds, neither the Trust nor any of the individual Funds is deemed to be a “commodity pool operator” under the CEA, and, accordingly, they are not subject to registration or regulation as such under the CEA.

Upon entering into futures contracts, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities, equal in value to the amount of a Fund’s obligation under the contract (less any applicable margin deposits and any assets that constitute “cover” for such obligation), will be segregated with a Fund’s custodian.

Unlike when a Fund purchases or sells a security, no price is paid or received by a Fund upon the purchase or sale of a futures contract, although a Fund is required to deposit with its custodian in a segregated account in the name of the futures broker an amount of cash and/or U.S. Government securities in order to initiate and maintain open positions in futures contracts. This amount is known as “initial margin.” The nature of initial margin in futures transactions is different from that of margin in security transactions, in that futures contract margin does not involve the borrowing of funds by a Fund to finance the transactions. Rather, initial margin is in the nature of a performance bond or good faith deposit intended to assure completion of the contract (delivery or acceptance of the underlying security or other asset) that is returned to a Fund upon termination of the futures contract, assuming all contractual obligations have been satisfied. Minimum initial margin requirements are established by the relevant futures exchange and may be changed. Brokers may establish deposit requirements which are higher than the exchange minimums. Futures contracts are customarily purchased and sold on margin which may range upward from less than 5% of the value of the contract being traded. Subsequent payments, called “variation margin,” to and from the broker (or the custodian) are made on a daily basis as the price of the underlying security or other asset fluctuates, a process known as “marking to market.” If the futures contract price changes to the extent that the margin on deposit does not satisfy margin requirements, payment of additional variation margin will be required. Conversely, a change in the contract value may reduce the required margin, resulting in a repayment of excess margin to the contract holder. Variation margin payments are made for as long as the contract remains open. A Fund expects to earn interest income on its margin deposits.

 

27


Table of Contents

 

Although futures contracts by their terms call for actual delivery or acceptance of securities or other assets (stock index futures contracts or futures contracts that reference other intangible assets do not permit delivery of the referenced assets), the contracts usually are closed out before the settlement date without the making or taking of delivery. A Fund may elect to close some or all of its futures positions at any time prior to their expiration. The purpose of taking such action would be to reduce or eliminate the position then currently held by a Fund. Closing out an open futures position is done by taking an opposite position (“buying” a contract which has previously been “sold,” “selling” a contract previously “purchased”) in an identical contract (i.e., the same aggregate amount of the specific type of security or other asset with the same delivery date) to terminate the position. Final determinations are made as to whether the price of the initial sale of the futures contract exceeds or is below the price of the offsetting purchase, or whether the purchase price exceeds or is below the offsetting sale price. Final determinations of variation margin are then made, additional cash is required to be paid by or released to a Fund, and a Fund realizes a loss or a gain. Brokerage commissions are incurred when a futures contract is bought or sold.

Successful use of futures contracts by a Fund is subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of interest rates and other factors affecting securities and commodities markets. This requires different skills and techniques than those required to predict changes in the prices of individual securities. A Fund, therefore, bears the risk that future market trends will be incorrectly predicted.

The risk of loss in trading futures contracts in some strategies can be substantial, due both to the relatively low margin deposits required and the potential for an extremely high degree of leverage involved in futures contracts. As a result, a relatively small price movement in a futures contract may result in an immediate and substantial loss to the investor. For example, if at the time of purchase, 10% of the value of the futures contract is deposited as margin, a subsequent 10% decrease in the value of the futures contract would result in a total loss of the margin deposit, before any deduction for the transaction costs, if the account were then closed out. A 15% decrease would result in a loss equal to 150% of the original margin deposit if the contract were closed out. Thus, a purchase or sale of a futures contract may result in losses in excess of the amount posted as initial margin for the contract.

In the event of adverse price movements, a Fund would continue to be required to make daily cash payments in order to maintain its required margin. In such a situation, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell portfolio securities in order to meet daily margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. The inability to close the futures position also could have an adverse impact on the ability to hedge effectively.

To reduce or eliminate a hedge position held by a Fund, a Fund may seek to close out a position. The ability to establish and close out positions will be subject to the development and maintenance of a liquid secondary market. It is not certain that this market will develop or continue to exist for a particular futures contract, which may limit a Fund’s ability to realize its profits or limit its losses. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain contracts; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions, closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of contracts, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of contracts (or a particular class or series of contracts), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of contracts) would cease to exist, although outstanding contracts on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

Interest Rate Futures Contracts. Bond prices are established in both the cash market and the futures market. In the cash market, bonds are purchased and sold with payment for the full purchase price of the bond being

 

28


Table of Contents

made in cash, generally within five business days after the trade. In the futures market, a contract is made to purchase or sell a bond in the future for a set price on a certain date. Historically, the prices for bonds established in the futures markets have tended to move generally in the aggregate in concert with the cash market prices and have maintained fairly predictable relationships. Accordingly, a Fund may use interest rate futures contracts as a defense, or hedge, against anticipated interest rate changes. A Fund presently could accomplish a similar result to that which it hopes to achieve through the use of interest rate futures contracts by selling bonds with long maturities and investing in bonds with short maturities when interest rates are expected to increase, or conversely, selling bonds with short maturities and investing in bonds with long maturities when interest rates are expected to decline. However, because of the liquidity that is often available in the futures market, the protection is more likely to be achieved, perhaps at a lower cost and without changing the rate of interest being earned by a Fund, through using futures contracts.

Interest rate futures contracts are traded in an auction environment on the floors of several exchanges principally, the Chicago Board of Trade, the Chicago Mercantile Exchange and the New York Futures Exchange. Each exchange guarantees performance under contract provisions through a clearing corporation, a nonprofit organization managed by the exchange membership. A public market exists in futures contracts covering various financial instruments including long-term U.S. Treasury Bonds and Notes; GNMA modified pass-through mortgage backed securities; three-month U.S. Treasury Bills; and ninety-day commercial paper. A Fund may also invest in exchange-traded Eurodollar contracts, which are interest rate futures on the forward level of LIBOR. These contracts are generally considered liquid securities and trade on the Chicago Mercantile Exchange. Such Eurodollar contracts are generally used to “lock-in” or hedge the future level of short-term rates. A Fund may trade in any interest rate futures contracts for which there exists a public market, including, without limitation, the foregoing instruments.

Index Futures Contracts. An index futures contract is a contract to buy or sell units of an index at a specified future date at a price agreed upon when the contract is made. Entering into a contract to buy units of an index is commonly referred to as buying or purchasing a contract or holding a long position in the index. Entering into a contract to sell units of an index is commonly referred to as selling a contract or holding a short position in the index. A unit is the current value of the index. A Fund may enter into stock index futures contracts, debt index futures contracts, or other index futures contracts appropriate to its objective(s).

There are several risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. One risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged.

Municipal Bond Index Futures Contracts. Municipal bond index futures contracts may act as a hedge against changes in market conditions. A municipal bond index assigns values daily to the municipal bonds included in the index based on the independent assessment of dealer-to-dealer municipal bond brokers. A municipal bond index futures contract represents a firm commitment by which two parties agree to take or make delivery of an amount equal to a specified dollar amount multiplied by the difference between the municipal bond index value on the last trading date of the contract and the price at which the futures contract is originally struck. No physical delivery of the underlying securities in the index is made.

Options on Futures Contracts. A Fund may purchase and write call and put options on those futures contracts that it is permitted to buy or sell. A Fund may use such options on futures contracts in lieu of writing options directly on the underlying securities or other assets or purchasing and selling the underlying futures contracts. Such options generally operate in the same manner as options purchased or written directly on the underlying investments. A futures option gives the holder, in return for the premium paid, the right to buy from (call) or sell to (put) the writer of the option a futures contract at a specified price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise, the writer of the option is obligated to pay the difference between the cash value of the

 

29


Table of Contents

futures contract and the exercise price. Like the buyer or seller of a futures contract, the holder or writer of an option has the right to terminate its position prior to the scheduled expiration of the option by selling or purchasing an option of the same series, at which time the person entering into the closing purchase transaction will realize a gain or loss. There is no guarantee that such closing purchase transactions can be effected.

A Fund will enter into written options on futures contracts only when, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities equal in value to the underlying security’s or other asset’s value (less any applicable margin deposits) have been deposited in a segregated account. A Fund will be required to deposit initial margin and maintenance margin with respect to put and call options on futures contracts written by it pursuant to brokers’ requirements similar to those described above.

Investments in futures options involve some of the same risks that are involved in connection with investments in futures contracts (for example, the existence of a liquid secondary market). In addition, the purchase of an option also entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option purchased. There may be circumstances when the purchase of a call or put option on a futures contract would result in a loss to a Fund when the purchase or sale of a futures contract would not, such as when there is no movement in the prices of the hedged investments. In general, the market prices of options can be expected to be more volatile than the market prices on the underlying futures contracts. Compared to the purchase or sale of futures contracts, however, the purchase of call or put options on futures contracts may frequently involve less potential risk to a Fund because the maximum amount at risk is the premium paid for the options (plus transaction costs).

Successful use of index futures by a Fund is also subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of the market. It is possible that, for example, where a Fund has sold futures to hedge its portfolio against a decline in the market, the index on which the futures are written may advance and the value of securities held in a Fund’s portfolio may decline. If this occurred, a Fund would lose money on the futures and also experience a decline in the value of its portfolio securities, as a Fund’s ability to effectively hedge all or a portion of the securities in its portfolio, in anticipation of or during a market decline, through transactions in futures or put options on stock indices, depends on the degree to which price movements in the underlying index correlate with the price movements of the securities held by a Fund. Inasmuch as a Fund’s securities will not duplicate the components of an index, the correlation will not be perfect. Consequently, a Fund bears the risk that the prices of its securities being hedged will not move to the same extent as do the prices of its put options on the stock indices. It is also possible that, if a Fund has hedged against the possibility of a decline in the market adversely affecting securities held in its portfolio and securities prices increase instead, a Fund will lose part or all of the benefit of the increased values of those securities that it has hedged, because it will have offsetting losses in its futures positions. In addition, in such situations, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell securities to meet daily variation margin requirements.

In addition to the possibility that there may be an imperfect correlation, or no correlation at all, between movements in the index futures and the securities of the portfolio being hedged, the prices of index futures may not correlate perfectly with movements in the underlying index due to certain market distortions. First, all participants in the futures markets are subject to margin deposit and maintenance requirements. Rather than meeting additional margin deposit requirements, investors may close futures contracts through offsetting transactions, which would distort the normal relationship between the index and futures markets. Second, margin requirements in the futures market are less onerous than margin requirements in the securities market, and as a result, the futures market may attract more speculators than the securities market. Increased participation by speculators in the futures market may also cause temporary price distortions. Due to the possibility of price distortions in the futures market, and also because of the imperfect correlation between movements in an index and movements in the prices of index futures, even a correct forecast of general market trends by the Adviser may still not result in a successful hedging transaction.

There is also the risk of loss by a Fund of margin deposits in the event of bankruptcy of a broker with whom a Fund has an open position in a futures contract or related option. Most futures exchanges limit the amount of

 

30


Table of Contents

fluctuation permitted in some contract prices during a single trading day. The daily limit establishes the maximum amount that the price of a futures contract may vary either up or down from the previous day’s settlement price at the end of a trading session. Once the daily limit has been reached in a particular type of contract, no trades may be made on that day at a price beyond that limit. The daily limit governs only price movement during a particular trading day and, therefore, does not limit potential losses, because the limit may prevent the liquidation of unfavorable positions. Futures contract prices have occasionally moved to the daily limit for several consecutive trading days with little or no trading, thereby preventing prompt liquidation of futures positions and subjecting some futures traders to substantial losses.

Options on Index Futures Contracts. A Fund may also purchase and sell options on index futures contracts. Options on index futures give the purchaser the right, in return for the premium paid, to assume a position in an index futures contract (a long position if the option is a call and a short position if the option is a put), at a specified exercise price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise of the option, the delivery of the futures position by the writer of the option to the holder of the option will be accompanied by delivery of the accumulated balance in the writer’s futures margin account, which represents the amount by which the market price of the index futures contract, at exercise, exceeds (in the case of a call) or is less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option on the index future. If an option is exercised on the last trading day prior to the expiration date of the option, the settlement will be made entirely in cash equal to the difference between the exercise price of the option and the closing level of the index on which the future is based on the expiration date. Purchasers of options who fail to exercise their options prior to the exercise date suffer a loss of the premium paid.

There are various risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. For example, a risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged; there can be no assurance that the Adviser will be successful in doing so.

Use by Tax-Exempt Funds of Interest Rate and U.S. Treasury Security Futures Contracts and Options. If a Fund invests in tax-exempt securities, it may purchase and sell futures contracts and related options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities when, in the opinion of the Adviser, price movements in these security futures and related options will correlate closely with price movements in the tax-exempt securities which are the subject of the hedge. Interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities futures contracts require the seller to deliver, or the purchaser to take delivery of, the type of security called for in the contract at a specified date and price. Options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts give the purchaser the right in return for the premium paid to assume a position in a futures contract at the specified option exercise price at any time during the period of the option.

In addition to the risks generally involved in using futures contracts, there is also a risk that price movements in interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts and related options will not correlate closely with price movements in markets for tax-exempt securities.

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

A Fund may purchase and write (i.e., sell) put and call options. Such options may relate to particular stocks or stock indices, and may or may not be listed on a domestic or foreign securities exchange and may or may not be issued by the Options Clearing Corporation (OCC). Stock index options are put options and call options on various stock indices. In most respects, they are identical to listed options on common stocks.

There is a key difference between stock options and stock index options in connection with their exercise. In the case of stock options, the underlying security, common stock, is delivered. However, upon the exercise of an

 

31


Table of Contents

index option, settlement does not occur by delivery of the securities comprising the index. The option holder who exercises the index option receives an amount of cash if the closing level of the stock index upon which the option is based is greater than (in the case of a call) or less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option. This amount of cash is equal to the difference between the closing price of the stock index and the exercise price of the option expressed in dollars times a specified multiple. A stock index fluctuates with changes in the market value of the securities included in the index. For example, some stock index options are based on a broad market index, such as the S&P 500® Index or a narrower market index, such as the S&P 100® Index. Indices may also be based on an industry or market segment.

The successful use of a Fund’s options strategies depends on the ability of the Adviser to forecast interest rate and market movements correctly. When it purchases an option, a Fund runs the risk that it will lose its entire investment in the option in a relatively short period of time, unless a Fund exercises the option or enters into a closing sale transaction for such option during the life of the option. If the price of the underlying security does not rise (in the case of a call) or fall (in the case of a put) to an extent sufficient to cover the option premium and transaction costs, a Fund will lose part or all of its investment in the option. This contrasts with an investment by a Fund in the underlying securities, since a Fund may continue to hold its investment in those securities notwithstanding the lack of a change in price of those securities.

The effective use of options also depends on a Fund’s ability to terminate option positions at times when the Adviser deems it desirable to do so. Although a Fund will take an option position only if the Adviser believes there is a liquid secondary market for the option, there is no assurance that a Fund will be able to effect closing transactions at any particular time or at an acceptable price.

If a secondary trading market in options were to become unavailable, a Fund could no longer engage in closing transactions. The writer in such circumstances would be subject to the risk of market decline or appreciation in the instrument during such period. If an option purchased by a Fund expires unexercised, a Fund will realize a loss equal to the premium paid. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain options; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions or closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of options, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series of options), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of options) would cease to exist, although outstanding options on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying options purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on the options. If trading is interrupted in an underlying security, the trading of options on that security is normally halted as well. As a result, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be unable to close out its positions until options trading resumes, and it may be faced with losses if trading in the security reopens at a substantially different price. In addition, the OCC or other options markets may impose exercise restrictions. If a prohibition on exercise is imposed at a time when trading in the option has also been halted, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be locked into its position until one of the two restrictions has been lifted. If a prohibition on exercise remains in effect until an option owned by a Fund has expired, a Fund could lose the entire value of its option.

Special risks are presented by internationally traded options. Because of time differences between the United States and various foreign countries, and because different holidays are observed in different countries, foreign options markets may be open for trading during hours or on days when U.S. markets are closed. As a result, option premiums may not reflect the current prices of the underlying interest in the United States.

 

32


Table of Contents

 

Dealer (Over-the-Counter) Options. Dealer options are options negotiated individually through dealers rather than traded on an exchange. Certain risks are specific to dealer options. While a Fund might look to a clearing corporation to exercise exchange-traded options, if a Fund purchases a dealer option it must rely on the selling dealer to perform if a Fund exercises the option. Failure by the dealer to do so would result in the loss of the premium paid by a Fund as well as loss of the expected benefit of the transaction. Exchange-traded options generally have a continuous liquid market while dealer options more often may not. Consequently, a Fund can realize the value of a dealer option it has purchased only by exercising or reselling the option to the issuing dealer. Similarly, when a Fund writes a dealer option, a Fund can close out the option prior to its expiration only by entering into a closing purchase transaction with the dealer. While each Fund seeks to enter into dealer options only with dealers who will agree to and can enter into closing transactions with a Fund, no assurance exists that a Fund will at any time be able to liquidate a dealer option at a favorable price at any time prior to expiration. Unless a Fund, as a covered dealer call option writer, can effect a closing purchase transaction, it will not be able to liquidate securities (or other assets) used as cover until the option expires or is exercised. In the event of insolvency of the other party, a Fund may be unable to liquidate a dealer option. With respect to options written by a Fund, the inability to enter into a closing transaction may result in material losses to a Fund. For example, because a Fund must maintain a secured position with respect to any call option on a security it writes, a Fund may not sell the assets, that it has segregated to secure the position while it is obligated under the option. This requirement may impair a Fund’s ability to sell portfolio securities at a time when such sale might be advantageous.

A Fund generally will treat purchased dealer options as illiquid securities. A Fund may treat the cover used for written dealer options as liquid if the dealer agrees that a Fund may repurchase the dealer option it has written for a maximum price to be calculated by a predetermined formula. In such cases, the dealer option would be considered illiquid only to the extent the maximum purchase price under the formula exceeds the intrinsic value of the option.

Writing Covered Options. A Fund may write covered call options and covered put options on securities held in its portfolio when, in the opinion of the Adviser, such transactions are consistent with a Fund’s investment goal and policies. Call options written by a Fund give the purchaser the right to buy the underlying securities from a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price; put options give the purchaser the right to sell the underlying securities to a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price.

A Fund may write only covered options, which means that, so long as a Fund is obligated as the writer of a call option, it will own the underlying securities subject to the option (or comparable securities satisfying the cover requirements of securities exchanges). In the case of put options, a Fund will hold cash and/or high-grade short-term debt obligations equal to the price to be paid if the option is exercised. In addition, a Fund will be considered to have covered a put or call option if and to the extent that it holds an option that offsets some or all of the risk of the option it has written. A Fund may write combinations of covered puts and calls (straddles) on the same underlying security.

A Fund will receive a premium from writing a put or call option, which increases a Fund’s return on the underlying security if the option expires unexercised or is closed out at a profit. The amount of the premium reflects, among other things, the relationship between the exercise price and the current market value of the underlying security, the volatility of the underlying security, the amount of time remaining until expiration, current interest rates, and the effect of supply and demand in the options market and in the market for the underlying security. By writing a call option, a Fund limits its opportunity to profit from any increase in the market value of the underlying security above the exercise price of the option but continues to bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security. By writing a put option, a Fund assumes the risk that it may be required to purchase the underlying security for an exercise price higher than the security’s then-current market value, resulting in a potential capital loss unless the security subsequently appreciates in value.

 

33


Table of Contents

 

A Fund’s obligation to sell an instrument subject to a call option written by it, or to purchase an instrument subject to a put option written by it, may be terminated prior to the expiration date of the option by a Fund’s execution of a closing purchase transaction, which is effected by purchasing on an exchange an offsetting option of the same series (i.e., same underlying instrument, exercise price and expiration date) as the option previously written. A closing purchase transaction will ordinarily be effected in order to realize a profit on an outstanding option, to prevent an underlying instrument from being called, to permit the sale of the underlying instrument or to permit the writing of a new option containing different terms on such underlying instrument. A Fund realizes a profit or loss from a closing purchase transaction if the cost of the transaction (option premium plus transaction costs) is less or more than the premium received from writing the option. Because increases in the market price of a call option generally reflect increases in the market price of the security underlying the option, any loss resulting from a closing purchase transaction may be offset in whole or in part by unrealized appreciation of the underlying security.

If a Fund writes a call option but does not own the underlying security, and when it writes a put option, a Fund may be required to deposit cash or securities with its broker as “margin” or collateral for its obligation to buy or sell the underlying security. As the value of the underlying security varies, a Fund may also have to deposit additional margin with the broker. Margin requirements are complex and are fixed by individual brokers, subject to minimum requirements currently imposed by the Federal Reserve Board and by stock exchanges and other self-regulatory organizations.

Purchasing Put Options. A Fund may purchase put options to protect its portfolio holdings in an underlying security against a decline in market value. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the put option since a Fund, as holder of the put option, is able to sell the underlying security at the put exercise price regardless of any decline in the underlying security’s market price. For a put option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must decline sufficiently below the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. By using put options in this manner, a Fund will reduce any profit it might otherwise have realized from appreciation of the underlying security by the premium paid for the put option and by transaction costs.

Purchasing Call Options. A Fund may purchase call options to hedge against an increase in the price of securities that a Fund wants ultimately to buy. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the call option since a Fund, as holder of the call option, is able to buy the underlying security at the exercise price regardless of any increase in the underlying security’s market price. In order for a call option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must rise sufficiently above the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. These costs will reduce any profit a Fund might have realized had it bought the underlying security at the time it purchased the call option.

Over-the-Counter (OTC) Options. A Fund will enter into OTC options transactions only with primary dealers in U.S. Government securities and, in the case of OTC options written by a Fund, only pursuant to agreements that will assure that a Fund will at all times have the right to repurchase the option written by it from the dealer at a specified formula price. A Fund will treat the amount by which such formula price exceeds the amount, if any, by which the option may be “in-the-money” as an illiquid investment. It is the present policy of a Fund not to enter into any OTC option transaction if, as a result, more than 15% (10% in some cases, refer to your Fund’s prospectuses) of a Fund’s net assets would be invested in (i) illiquid investments (determined under the foregoing formula) relating to OTC options written by a Fund, (ii) OTC options purchased by a Fund, (iii) securities which are not readily marketable, and (iv) repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days.

Index Options. As an alternative to purchasing call and put options on index futures, a Fund may purchase call and put options on the underlying indices themselves. Such options could be used in a manner identical to the use of options on index futures. Options involving securities indices provide the holder with the right to make or receive a cash settlement upon exercise of the option based on movements in the relevant index. Such options must be listed on a national securities exchange and issued by the OCC. Such options may relate to particular securities or to various stock indices, except that a Fund may not write covered options on an index.

 

34


Table of Contents

 

Foreign Stock Index Options. A Fund may, for the purpose of hedging its portfolio, subject to applicable securities regulations, purchase and write put and call options on foreign stock indices listed on foreign and domestic stock exchanges.

Swap Agreements

Swap agreements are derivative instruments that can be individually negotiated and structured to include exposure to a variety of different types of investments or market factors. Depending on their structure, swap agreements may increase or decrease a Fund’s exposure to long- or short-term interest rates, foreign currency values, mortgage securities, corporate borrowing rates, or other factors such as security prices or inflation rates. A Fund may enter into a variety of swap agreements, including interest rate, index, commodity, equity, credit default and currency exchange rate swap agreements, and other types of swap agreements such as caps, collars and floors. A Fund also may enter into swaptions, which are options to enter into a swap agreement.

In a typical interest rate swap, one party agrees to make regular payments equal to a floating interest rate times a “notional principal amount,” in return for payments equal to a fixed rate times the same amount, for a specified period of time. If a swap agreement provides for payments in different currencies, the parties might agree to exchange notional principal amount as well. In a total return swap agreement, the non-floating rate side of the swap is based on the total return of an individual security, a basket of securities, an index or another reference asset. Swaps may also depend on other prices or rates, such as the value of an index or mortgage prepayment rates.

In a typical cap or floor agreement, one party agrees to make payments only under specified circumstances, usually in return for payment of a fee by the other party. For example, the buyer of an interest rate cap obtains the right to receive payments to the extent that a specified interest rate exceeds an agreed-upon level, while the seller of an interest rate floor is obligated to make payments to the extent that a specified interest rate falls below an agreed-upon level. Caps and floors have an effect similar to buying or writing options. A collar combines elements of buying a cap and selling a floor.

Swap agreements will tend to shift a Fund’s investment exposure from one type of investment to another. For example, if a Fund agreed to pay fixed rates in exchange for floating rates while holding fixed-rate bonds, the swap would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to long-term interest rates. Another example is if a Fund agreed to exchange payments in dollars for payments in foreign currency, the swap agreement would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to U.S. interest rates and increase its exposure to foreign currency and interest rates.

Swap agreements are sophisticated hedging instruments that typically involve a small investment of cash relative to the magnitude of risks assumed. As a result, swaps can be highly volatile and may have a considerable impact on a Fund’s performance. Depending on how they are used, swap agreements may increase or decrease the overall volatility of a Fund’s investments and its share price and yield. Additionally, whether a Fund’s use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment objective will depend on the Adviser’s ability correctly to predict whether certain types of investments likely are to produce greater returns than other investments. Because they are two party contracts and because they may have terms of greater than seven days, swap agreements may be considered to be illiquid. Moreover, a Fund bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. The most significant factor in the performance of swap agreements is the change in the specific interest rate, currency, or other factor that determines the amounts of payments due to and from a Fund. If a swap agreement calls for payments by a Fund, a Fund must be prepared to make such payments when due. In addition, if the counterparty’s creditworthiness declines, the value of a swap agreement likely would decline, potentially resulting in losses for a Fund. A Fund will closely monitor the credit of a swap agreement counterparty in order to attempt to minimize this risk. A Fund may also suffer losses if it is unable to terminate outstanding swap agreements (either by assignment or other disposition) or reduce its exposure through offsetting transactions (i.e., by entering into an offsetting swap agreement with the same party or a similarly creditworthy party).

 

35


Table of Contents

 

Credit Default Swap Agreements. A Fund may enter into credit default swap agreements, which may have as reference obligations one or more securities or a basket of securities that are or are not currently held by a Fund. The protection “buyer” in a credit default contract is generally obligated to pay the protection “seller” an upfront or a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract provided that no credit event, such as a default, on a reference obligation has occurred. If a credit event occurs, the seller generally must pay the buyer the “par value” (full notional value) of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity described in the swap, or the seller may be required to deliver the related net cash amount, if the swap is cash settled. A Fund may be either the buyer or seller in the transaction. If a Fund is a buyer and no credit event occurs, a Fund may recover nothing if the swap is held through its termination date. However, if a credit event occurs, the buyer generally may elect to receive the full notional value of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity whose value may have significantly decreased. As a seller, a Fund generally receives an upfront payment or a fixed rate of income throughout the term of the swap provided that there is no credit event. As the seller, a Fund would effectively add leverage to its portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Credit default swap agreements may involve greater risks than if a Fund had invested in the reference obligation directly since, in addition to risks relating to the reference obligation, credit default swaps are subject to illiquidity risk, counterparty risk and credit risk. A Fund will enter into credit default swap agreements generally with counterparties that meet certain standards of creditworthiness. A buyer generally will lose its investment and recover nothing if no credit event occurs and the swap is held to its termination date. If a credit event were to occur, the value of any deliverable obligation received by the seller, coupled with the upfront or periodic payments previously received, may be less than the full notional value it pays to the buyer, resulting in a loss of value to the seller.

Equity Swaps. A Fund may engage in equity swaps. Equity swaps allow the parties to the swap agreement to exchange components of return on one equity investment (e.g., a basket of equity securities or an index) for a component of return on another non-equity or equity investment, including an exchange of differential rates of return. Equity swaps may be used to invest in a market without owning or taking physical custody of securities in circumstances where direct investment may be restricted for legal reasons or is otherwise impractical. Equity swaps also may be used for other purposes, such as hedging or seeking to increase total return.

The values of equity swaps can be very volatile. To the extent that the Adviser does not accurately analyze and predict the potential relative fluctuation on the components swapped with the other party, a Fund may suffer a loss. The value of some components of an equity swap (such as the dividend on a common stock) may also be sensitive to changes in interest rates. Furthermore, during the period a swap is outstanding, a Fund may suffer a loss if the counterparty defaults.

Total Return Swap Agreements. Total return swap agreements are contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in market value of the assets underlying the contract, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or securities indices during the specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate or the total return from other underlying assets. Total return swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Total return swap agreements may effectively add leverage to a Fund’s portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Total return swap agreements are subject to the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations to a Fund thereunder, and conversely, that a Fund will not be able to meet its obligation to the counterparty. Generally, a Fund will enter into total return swaps on a net basis (i.e., the two payment streams are netted against one another with a Fund receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments). The net amount of the excess, if any, of a Fund’s obligations over its entitlements with respect to each

 

36


Table of Contents

total return swap will be accrued on a daily basis, and an amount of liquid assets having an aggregate net asset value at least equal to the accrued excess will be segregated by a Fund. If the total return swap transaction is entered into on other than a net basis, the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be accrued on a daily basis, and the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be segregated by a Fund in an amount equal to or greater than the market value of the liabilities under the total return swap agreement or the amount it would have cost a Fund initially to make an equivalent direct investment, plus or minus any amount a Fund is obligated to pay or is to receive under the total return swap agreement.

Variance, Volatility and Correlation Swap Agreements. Variance and volatility swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the volatility of certain referenced assets. Correlation swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the correlation between the prices of different assets or different market rates.

Dollar Rolls

Dollar rolls involve selling securities (e.g., mortgage-backed securities or U.S. Treasury securities) and simultaneously entering into a commitment to purchase those or similar (same collateral type, coupon and maturity) securities on a specified future date and price. Mortgage dollar rolls and U.S. Treasury rolls are types of dollar rolls. A Fund foregoes principal and interest paid on the securities during the “roll” period. A Fund is compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the lower forward price for the future purchase of the securities as well as the interest earned on the cash proceeds of the initial sale.

Dollar rolls involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase may decline below the repurchase price or that the transaction costs may exceed the return earned by a Fund from the transaction. Dollar rolls also involve risk to a Fund if the other party should default on its obligation and a Fund is delayed or prevented from completing the transaction. In the event that the buyer of securities under a dollar roll files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the dollar roll may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, the security to be delivered in the future may turn out to be inferior to the security sold upon entering into the transaction.

Foreign Currency Transactions

Foreign currency transactions may be used to protect, to some extent, against uncertainty in the level of future currency exchange rates by establishing a fixed exchange rate. Foreign currency transactions may involve the purchase or sale of foreign currencies on a “spot” (cash) basis at the prevailing exchange rate or may involve “forward contracts” that allow a Fund to purchase or sell foreign currencies at a future date. Forward contracts may be used for “transaction hedging,” “position hedging” and “cross-hedging.” A Fund may use forward sale contracts to sell an amount of a foreign currency approximating the value of a Fund’s securities denominated in the foreign security when that foreign currency suffers a substantial decline against the U.S. dollar. A Fund may use forward purchase contracts to purchase a foreign currency when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a substantial decline against the foreign currency. Although these transactions tend to minimize the risk of loss due to a decline in the value of the hedged currency, they also tend to limit any potential gain that might be realized if the value of the hedged currency increases.

Transaction hedging may allow a Fund to “lock in” the U.S. dollar price of a security it has agreed to purchase or sell, or the U.S. dollar equivalent of a dividend or interest rate payment in a foreign currency. A Fund may use transaction hedging to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currency during the period between the date on which the security is purchased or sold, or on which the dividend or interest payment is declared, and the date on which such payments are made or received.

 

37


Table of Contents

 

Position hedging may allow a Fund to protect against an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currencies in which its portfolio securities are denominated. A Fund may use position hedging when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a decline against the foreign currency by entering into a forward purchase contract to purchase that foreign currency for a fixed dollar amount.

Cross-hedging may allow a Fund to enter into a forward contract to sell a different foreign currency for a fixed U.S. dollar amount when it is believed that the U.S. dollar value of the currency to be sold pursuant to the forward contract will fall if there is a decline in the U.S. dollar value of the currency in which a Fund’s securities are denominated.

A Fund also may purchase exchange-listed and over-the-counter call and put options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts. Options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts give the holder a right to buy or sell the underlying foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts for a specified period of time and for a specified amount. The value of an option on foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts reflects the value of an exchange rate, which depends on the relative values of the U.S. dollar and the relevant foreign currency.

Engaging in foreign currency transactions is subject to certain risks. For example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the dollar value of any securities held by a Fund denominated in that currency. It is impossible to forecast with precision the market value of portfolio securities at the expiration or maturity of a forward or futures contract, which may make it necessary for a Fund to purchase additional foreign currency on the spot market if the market value of the security being hedged is less than the amount of foreign currency a Fund is obligated to deliver at the time a Fund sells the security being hedged. The value of any currency, including the U.S. dollar, may be affected by political and economic factors applicable to the issuer’s country. The exchange rates of currencies also may be affected adversely by governmental actions. Transaction, position and cross-hedging do not eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of securities that a Fund owns or intends to purchase or sell and may limit the amount of potential gain that might result from the increase in value of the currency being hedged. Settlement procedures relating to a Fund’s foreign currency transactions may be more complex than those relating to investments in securities of U.S. issuers.

Foreign Securities

Foreign securities include debt, equity and derivative securities that the Adviser determines are “foreign” based on the consideration of an issuer’s domicile, its principal place of business, its primary stock exchange listing, the source of its revenue or other factors. Foreign securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Foreign securities may include depositary receipts, such as American Depositary Receipts (ADRs), European Depositary Receipts (EDRs) and Global Depositary Receipts (GDRs). ADRs are U.S. dollar denominated receipts issued in registered form by a domestic bank or trust company that evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by a foreign issuer. EDRs are foreign currency-denominated receipts issued in Europe, typically by foreign banks or trust companies and foreign branches of domestic banks, that evidence ownership of foreign or domestic securities. GDRs are receipts structured similarly to ADRs and EDRs and are marketed globally. Depositary receipts will not necessarily be denominated in the same currency as their underlying securities. In general, ADRs, in registered form, are designed for use in the U.S. securities markets, and EDRs, in bearer form, are designed for use in European securities markets. GDRs are tradable both in the United States and in Europe and are designed for use throughout the world. A Fund may invest in depositary receipts through “sponsored” or “unsponsored” facilities. A sponsored facility is established jointly by the issuer

 

38


Table of Contents

of the underlying security and a depositary, whereas a depositary may establish an unsponsored facility without participation by the issuer of the deposited security. Holders of unsponsored depositary receipts generally bear all the costs of such facilities and the depositary of an unsponsored facility frequently is under no obligation to distribute interest holder communications received from the issuer of the deposited security or to pass through voting rights to the holders of such receipts in respect of the deposited securities. The issuers of unsponsored depositary receipts are not obligated to disclose material information in the United States, and, therefore, there may be limited information available regarding such issuers and/or limited correlation between available information and the market value of the depositary receipts.

Due to the potential for foreign withholding taxes, Morgan Stanley Capital International (MSCI) publishes two versions of its indices reflecting the reinvestment of dividends using two different methodologies: gross dividends and net dividends. While both versions reflect reinvested dividends, they differ with respect to the manner in which taxes associated with dividend payments are treated. In calculating the net dividends version, MSCI incorporates reinvested dividends applying the withholding tax rate applicable to foreign non-resident institutional investors that do not benefit from double taxation treaties. The Adviser believes that the net dividends version of MSCI indices better reflects the returns U.S. investors might expect were they to invest directly in the component securities of an MSCI index.

Investing in foreign securities is subject to certain risks. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates also may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies or U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Additionally, the U.S. dollar value of a foreign security tends to decrease when the value of the U.S. dollar rises against the foreign currency in which the security is denominated and tends to increase when the value of the U.S. dollar falls against such currency. A Fund may attempt to minimize the risk from adverse changes in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies by purchasing and selling forward foreign currency exchange contracts and foreign currency futures contracts and related options. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that a Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees also are generally higher for foreign securities. A Fund may have limited legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain debt securities issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which would reduce a Fund’s return on these securities.

Other risks of investing in foreign securities include: possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the notification of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; adverse impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and that foreign companies generally are not subject to accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards comparable to those mandated for domestic companies.

Risks associated with investments in foreign securities are increased with respect to investments in emerging market countries. Political and economic structures in many emerging market countries, especially those in Eastern Europe, the Pacific Basin and the Far East, are undergoing significant evolutionary changes and rapid development, and may lack the social, political and economic stability of more developed countries. Investing in emerging market securities also involves risks beyond the risks applicable to foreign investments. For example, some emerging market countries may have fixed or managed currencies that are not free-floating against the U.S. dollar. Further, certain currencies may not be traded internationally, and some countries with emerging securities markets have sustained long periods of very high inflation or rapid fluctuation in inflation rates which can have negative effects on a country’s economy and securities markets.

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Agreements)

Guaranteed investment contracts, or funding agreements, are debt instruments issued by insurance companies. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of the insurance

 

39


Table of Contents

company’s general account. The insurance company then credits to a Fund payments at negotiated, floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund will purchase guaranteed investment contracts only from issuers that, at the time of purchase, meet certain credit and quality standards.

Investing in guaranteed investment contracts is subject to certain risks. In general, guaranteed investment contracts are not assignable or transferable without the permission of the issuing insurance companies, and an active secondary market does not exist for these investments. In addition, the issuer may not be able to pay the principal amount to a Fund on seven days notice or less, at which time the investment may be considered illiquid under applicable SEC regulatory guidance and subject to certain restrictions.

Illiquid Securities

Illiquid securities are defined by a Fund consistent with SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is an asset which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which a Fund has valued the investment on its books. Some securities, such as those not registered under U.S. securities laws, cannot be sold in public transactions. Subject to its investment policies, a Fund may invest in illiquid investments and may invest in certain restricted securities that are deemed to be illiquid securities.

Initial Public Offerings

A Fund may invest in initial public offerings (IPOs) of common stock or other primary or secondary syndicated offerings of equity or debt securities issued by a corporate issuer. Fixed income funds frequently invest in these types of offerings of debt securities. A purchase of IPO securities often involves higher transaction costs than those associated with the purchase of securities already traded on exchanges or markets. IPO securities are subject to market risk and liquidity risk. The market value of recently issued IPO securities may fluctuate considerably due to factors such as the absence of a prior public market, unseasoned trading and speculation, a potentially small number of securities available for trading, limited information about the issuer, and other factors. A Fund may hold IPO securities for a period of time, or may sell them soon after the purchase. Investments in IPOs could have a magnified impact — either positive or negative — on a Fund’s performance while the Fund’s assets are relatively small. The impact of an IPO on a Fund’s performance may tend to diminish as the Fund’s assets grow. In circumstances when investments in IPOs make a significant contribution to a Fund’s performance, there can be no assurance that similar contributions from IPOs will continue in the future.

Investing in a Master Portfolio

Investing in a Master Portfolio is the way in which the Fund may seek to achieve its investment objective. The 1940 Act permits the Fund, under certain conditions, to invest all of its assets in another mutual fund. Under this structure, called a master/feeder structure, the Fund (the Feeder Fund) invests all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio with the same investment objective, principal investment strategies and risks as the Feeder Fund. The Master Portfolio is a separate series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC, which is organized as a limited liability company under the laws of the State of Delaware, and is itself a registered investment company in the Columbia Funds Family. Other entities (e.g., other investment companies, commingled trust funds, institutional and certain individual investors), along with other Master Portfolios, may invest in the Master Portfolio from time to time. Accordingly, there also may be other investment companies, as well as other investment vehicles, through which you can invest in the Master Portfolio that may have higher or lower fees and expenses than those of the Feeder Fund and that, therefore, may have different performance results than the Feeder Fund.

The primary advantages of the master/feeder structure are potential economies of scale. For example, the larger asset size of the Master Portfolio may allow it to purchase securities and engage in brokerage transactions on more favorable terms than might otherwise be available to the Feeder Fund alone, as well as, over time, to enjoy other benefits associated with achieving economies of scale.

 

40


Table of Contents

 

Investing in a Master Portfolio is subject to certain risks. As with any mutual fund, other investors in the Master Portfolio could control the results of voting at the Master Portfolio level in certain instances (e.g., a change in fundamental policies by the Master Portfolio which was not approved by the Fund’s shareholders). This could cause the Feeder Fund to withdraw its investment in the Master Portfolio. The Feeder Fund also may withdraw its investment in the Master Portfolio at any time if the Board determines that it is in the best interest of the Feeder Fund to do so. Upon such withdrawal, the Board would consider what action should be taken, including the investment of all of the assets of the Feeder Fund in another pooled investment entity having, for example, the same (or similar) investment objective, principal investment strategies and risks as the Feeder Fund or the hiring of an investment adviser to manage the Feeder Fund’s assets in accordance with its investment objective and principal investment strategies. Further, the withdrawal of other entities that may from time to time invest in the Master Portfolio could have an adverse effect on the performance of the Master Portfolio and the Feeder Fund, such as decreased economies of scale and increased per share operating expenses.

Investments in Other Investment Companies

Investing in other investment companies may be a means by which a Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective. A Fund may invest in securities issued by other investment companies within the limits prescribed by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive orders currently or in the future obtained by a Fund from the SEC.

Except with respect to funds structured as funds-of-funds or so-called master/feeder funds, the 1940 Act generally requires that a fund limit its investments in another investment company or series thereof so that, as determined at the time a securities purchase is made: (i) no more than 5% of the value of its total assets will be invested in the securities of any one investment company; (ii) no more than 10% of the value of its total assets will be invested in the aggregate in securities of other investment companies; and (iii) no more than 3% of the outstanding voting stock of any one investment company or series thereof will be owned by a fund or by companies controlled by a fund. Such other investment companies may include ETFs, which are shares of publicly traded unit investment trusts, open-end funds or depositary receipts that seek to track the performance of specific indexes or companies in related industries.

Investing in other investment companies is subject to certain risks. Although a Fund may derive certain advantages from being able to invest in shares of other investment companies, such as to be fully invested, there may be potential disadvantages. Investing in other investment companies may result in higher fees and expenses for a Fund and its shareholders. A shareholder may be charged fees not only on Fund shares held directly but also on the investment company shares that a Fund purchases.

In addition, investing in ETFs is subject to certain other risks. ETFs generally are subject to the same risks as the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track as well as to the risks of the specific sector or industry to which the ETF relates. ETFs also are subject to the risk that their prices may not totally correlate to the prices of the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track and the risk of possible trading halts due to market conditions or for other reasons.

Under the 1940 Act and rules and regulations thereunder, a Fund may purchase shares of affiliated funds, subject to certain conditions. Investing in affiliated funds may present certain actual or potential conflicts of interest. For more information about such actual and potential conflicts of interest, see Investment Advisory and Other Services — Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates — Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

Low and below investment grade securities (below investment grade securities are also known as “junk bonds”) are debt securities with the lowest investment grade rating (e.g., BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by

 

41


Table of Contents

Moody’s), that are below investment grade (e.g., lower than BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by Moody’s) or that are unrated but determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality. These types of securities may be issued to fund corporate transactions or restructurings, such as leveraged buyouts, mergers, acquisitions, debt reclassifications or similar events, are more speculative in nature than securities with higher ratings and tend to be more sensitive to credit risk, particularly during a downturn in the economy. These types of securities generally are issued by unseasoned companies without long track records of sales and earnings, or by companies or municipalities that have questionable credit strength. Low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities: (i) likely will have some quality and protective characteristics that, in the judgment of one or more NRSROs, are outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions; (ii) are speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation; and (iii) may have a less liquid secondary market, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities. Low and below investment grade securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities is subject to certain risks. The rates of return on these types of securities generally are higher than the rates of return available on more highly rated securities, but generally involve greater volatility of price and risk of loss of principal and income, including the possibility of default by or insolvency of the issuers of such securities. Accordingly, a Fund may be more dependent on the Adviser’s credit analysis with respect to these types of securities than is the case for more highly rated securities.

The market values of certain low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities tend to be more sensitive to individual corporate developments and changes in economic conditions than are the market value of more highly rated securities. In addition, issuers of low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities often are highly leveraged and may not have more traditional methods of financing available to them, so that their ability to service their debt obligations during an economic downturn or during sustained periods of rising interest rates may be impaired.

The risk of loss due to default is greater for low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities than it is for higher rated securities because low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities generally are unsecured and frequently are subordinated to more senior indebtedness. A Fund may incur additional expenses to the extent that it is required to seek recovery upon a default in the payment of principal or interest on its holdings of such securities. The existence of limited markets for lower-rated debt securities may diminish a Fund’s ability to: (i) obtain accurate market quotations for purposes of valuing such securities and calculating portfolio net asset value; and (ii) sell the securities at fair market value either to meet redemption requests or to respond to changes in the economy or in financial markets.

Many lower-rated securities are not registered for offer and sale to the public under the 1933Act. Investments in these restricted securities may be determined to be liquid (able to be sold within seven days at approximately the price at which they are valued by a Fund) pursuant to policies approved by the Fund’s Trustees. Investments in illiquid securities, including restricted securities that have not been determined to be liquid, may not exceed 15% of a Fund’s net assets. A Fund is not otherwise subject to any limitation on its ability to invest in restricted securities. Restricted securities may be less liquid than other lower-rated securities, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities.

Money Market Instruments

Money market instruments are high-quality, short-term debt obligations, which include: (i) bank obligations, including certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers’ acceptances; (ii) funding agreements; (iii) repurchase

 

42


Table of Contents

agreements; (iv) obligations of the United States, foreign countries and supranational entities, and each of their subdivisions, agencies and instrumentalities; (v) certain corporate debt securities, such as commercial paper, short-term corporate obligations and extendible commercial notes; (vi) participation interests; and (vii) municipal securities. Money market instruments may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in money market instruments is subject to certain risks. Money market instruments (other than certain U.S. Government obligations) are not backed or insured by the U.S. Government, its agencies or its instrumentalities. Accordingly, only the creditworthiness of an issuer, or guarantees of that issuer, support such instruments.

Mortgage-Backed Securities

Mortgage-backed securities are a type of asset-backed security and represent interests in, or debt instruments backed by, pools of underlying mortgages. In some cases, these underlying mortgages may be insured or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Mortgage-backed securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral (less fees paid to the originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral effectively pass through to such security holders. Mortgage-backed securities are created when mortgage originators (or mortgage loan sellers who have purchased mortgage loans from mortgage loan originators) sell the underlying mortgages to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying mortgage loans, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Mortgage-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Mortgage-backed securities may be issued or guaranteed by GNMA (also known as Ginnie Mae), FNMA (also known as Fannie Mae), or FHLMC (also known as Freddie Mac), but also may be issued or guaranteed by other issuers, including private companies. GNMA is a government-owned corporation that is an agency of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. It guarantees, with the full faith and credit of the United States, full and timely payment of all monthly principal and interest on its mortgage-backed securities. Until recently, FNMA and FHLMC were government-sponsored corporations owned entirely by private stockholders. Both issue mortgage-related securities that contain guarantees as to timely payment of interest and principal but that are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. The value of the companies’ securities fell sharply in 2008 due to concerns that the firms did not have sufficient capital to offset losses. In mid-2008, the U.S. Treasury was authorized to increase the size of home loans that FNMA and FHLMC could purchase in certain residential areas and, until 2009, to lend FNMA and FHLMC emergency funds and to purchase the companies’ stock. In September 2008, the U.S. Treasury announced that FNMA and FHLMC had been placed in conservatorship by the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), a newly created independent regulator. In addition to placing the companies in conservatorship, the U.S. Treasury announced three additional steps that it intended to take with respect to FNMA and FHLMC. First, the U.S. Treasury has entered into “Preferred Stock Purchase Agreements” (PSPAs) under which, if the FHFA determines that FNMA’s or FHLMC’s liabilities have exceeded its assets under generally accepted accounting principles, the U.S. Treasury will contribute cash capital to the company in an amount equal to the difference between liabilities and assets. The PSPAs are designed to provide protection to the senior and subordinated debt and the mortgage-backed securities issued by FNMA and FHLMC. Second, the U.S. Treasury established a new secured lending credit facility that was available to FNMA and FHLMC until December 2009. Third, the U.S. Treasury initiated a temporary program to purchase FNMA

 

43


Table of Contents

and FHLMC mortgage-backed securities that concluded in December 2009. Although the U.S. Government has provided support to FNMA and FHLMC, there can be no assurances that it will support these and other government sponsored enterprises in the future.

CMOs are debt obligations issued by special-purpose trusts, collateralized by underlying mortgage assets. Principal prepayments on underlying mortgage assets may cause the CMOs to be retired substantially earlier than their stated maturities or final distribution dates, resulting in a loss of all or part of the premium if any has been paid. Interest is paid or accrues on all classes of the CMOs on a periodic basis. The principal and interest payments on the underlying mortgage assets may be allocated among the various classes of CMOs in several ways. Typically, payments of principal, including any prepayments, on the underlying mortgage assets are applied to the classes in the order of their respective stated maturities or final distribution dates, so that no payment of principal is made on CMOs of a class until all CMOs of other classes having earlier stated maturities or final distribution dates have been paid in full.

REMICs are entities that own mortgages and elect REMIC status under the Code and, like CMOs, issue debt obligations collateralized by underlying mortgage assets that have characteristics similar to those issued by CMOs.

Investing in mortgage-backed securities is subject to certain risks, including, among others, prepayment, market and credit risks. Prepayment risk reflects the risk that borrowers may prepay their mortgages more quickly than expected, which may affect the security’s average maturity and rate of return. Whether or not a mortgage loan is prepaid is almost entirely controlled by the borrower. Borrowers are most likely to exercise prepayment options at the time when it is least advantageous to investors, generally prepaying mortgages as interest rates fall, and slowing payments as interest rates rise. Besides the effect of prevailing interest rates, the rate of prepayment and refinancing of mortgages also may be affected by home value appreciation, ease of the refinancing process and local economic conditions, among other factors. Market risk reflects the risk that the price of a security may fluctuate over time. The price of mortgage-backed securities can be particularly sensitive to prevailing interest rates, the length of time the security is expected to be outstanding and the liquidity of the issue. In a period of unstable interest rates, there may be decreased demand for certain types of mortgage-backed securities, which in turn may decrease their value. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of mortgage-backed securities may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or the underlying mortgage borrower has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for mortgage-backed securities that are backed by mortgages to so-called subprime borrowers (who may pose a greater risk of defaulting on their loans) or that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of a mortgage-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be. Mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers, whether or not such obligations are subject to guarantees by the private issuer, may entail greater risk than mortgage-backed securities guaranteed by the U.S. Government. The performance of mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers generally depends on the financial health of those institutions.

Municipal Securities

Municipal securities include debt obligations issued by governmental entities to obtain funds for various public purposes, including the construction of a wide range of public facilities, the refunding of outstanding obligations, the payment of general operating expenses, and the extension of loans to public institutions and facilities. Municipal securities can be classified into two principal categories, including “general obligation” bonds and other securities and “revenue” bonds and other securities. General obligation bonds are secured by the issuer’s full faith, credit and taxing power for the payment of principal and interest. Revenue securities are payable only from the revenues derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue source, such as the user of the facility being financed. Municipal securities also may include “moral obligation” securities, which normally are issued by special

 

44


Table of Contents

purpose public authorities. If the issuer of moral obligation securities is unable to meet its debt service obligations from current revenues, it may draw on a reserve fund, the restoration of which is a moral commitment but not a legal obligation of the governmental entity that created the special purpose public authority. Municipal securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Municipal securities may include municipal bonds, municipal notes and municipal leases. Municipal bonds are debt obligations of a governmental entity that obligate the municipality to pay the holder a specified sum of money at specified intervals and to repay the principal amount of the loan at maturity.

Municipal notes may be issued by governmental entities and other tax-exempt issuers in order to finance short-term cash needs or, occasionally, to finance construction. Most municipal notes are general obligations of the issuing entity payable from taxes or designated revenues expected to be received within the relevant fiscal period. Municipal notes generally have maturities of one year or less. Municipal notes can be subdivided into two sub-categories: (i) municipal commercial paper and (ii) municipal demand obligations.

Municipal commercial paper typically consists of very short-term unsecured negotiable promissory notes that are sold, for example, to meet seasonal working capital or interim construction financing needs of a governmental entity or agency. While these obligations are intended to be paid from general revenues or refinanced with long-term debt, they frequently are backed by letters of credit, lending agreements, note repurchase agreements or other credit facility agreements offered by banks or institutions.

Municipal demand obligations can be subdivided into two general types: variable rate demand notes and master demand obligations. Variable rate demand notes are tax-exempt municipal obligations or participation interests that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid on the notes. They permit the holder to demand payment of the notes, or to demand purchase of the notes at a purchase price equal to the unpaid principal balance, plus accrued interest either directly by the issuer or by drawing on a bank letter of credit or guaranty issued with respect to such note. The issuer of the municipal obligation may have a corresponding right to prepay at its discretion the outstanding principal of the note plus accrued interest upon notice comparable to that required for the holder to demand payment. The variable rate demand notes in which a Fund may invest are payable, or are subject to purchase, on demand usually on notice of seven calendar days or less. The terms of the notes generally provide that interest rates are adjustable at intervals ranging from daily to six months.

Master demand obligations are tax-exempt municipal obligations that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid and permit daily changes in the amount borrowed. The interest on such obligations is, in the opinion of counsel for the borrower, excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes (but not necessarily for alternative minimum tax purposes). Although there is no secondary market for master demand obligations, such obligations are considered by a Fund to be liquid because they are payable upon demand.

Municipal lease obligations are participations in privately arranged loans to state or local government borrowers. In general, such loans are unrated, in which case they will be determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality at the time of purchase to rated instruments that may be acquired by a Fund. Frequently, privately arranged loans have variable interest rates and may be backed by a bank letter of credit. In other cases, they may be unsecured or may be secured by assets not easily liquidated. Moreover, such loans in most cases are not backed by the taxing authority of the issuers and may have limited marketability or may be marketable only by virtue of a provision requiring repayment following demand by the lender.

Although lease obligations do not constitute general obligations of the municipal issuer to which the government’s taxing power is pledged, a lease obligation ordinarily is backed by the government’s covenant to

 

45


Table of Contents

budget for, appropriate, and make the payments due under the lease obligation. However, certain lease obligations contain “non-appropriation” clauses that provide that the government has no obligation to make lease or installment purchase payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a periodic basis. In the case of a “non-appropriation” lease, a Fund’s ability to recover under the lease in the event of non-appropriation or default likely will be limited to the repossession of the leased property in the event that foreclosure proves difficult.

Tender option bonds are municipal securities having relatively long maturities and bearing interest at a fixed interest rate substantially higher than prevailing short-term tax-exempt rates that is coupled with the agreement of a third party, such as a bank, broker/dealer or other financial institution, to grant the security holders the option, at periodic intervals, to tender their securities to the institution and receive the face value thereof. The financial institution receives periodic fees equal to the difference between the municipal security’s coupon rate and the rate that would cause the security to trade at face value on the date of determination.

Investing in municipal securities is subject to certain risks. There are variations in the quality of municipal securities, both within a particular classification and between classifications, and the rates of return on municipal securities can depend on a variety of factors, including general money market conditions, the financial condition of the issuer, general conditions of the municipal bond market, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. The ratings of NRSROs represent their opinions as to the quality of municipal securities. It should be emphasized, however, that these ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality, and municipal securities with the same maturity, interest rate, and rating may have different rates of return while municipal securities of the same maturity and interest rate with different ratings may have the same rate of return.

The payment of principal and interest on most municipal securities purchased by a Fund will depend upon the ability of the issuers to meet their obligations. An issuer’s obligations under its municipal securities are subject to the provisions of bankruptcy, insolvency, and other laws affecting the rights and remedies of creditors, such as the United States Bankruptcy Code. The power or ability of an issuer to meet its obligations for the payment of interest on and principal of its municipal securities may be materially adversely affected by litigation or other conditions.

There are particular considerations and risks relevant to investing in a portfolio of a single state’s municipal securities, such as the greater risk of the concentration of portfolio holdings.

The Funds ordinarily purchase municipal securities whose interest, in the opinion of bond counsel, is excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes. The opinion of bond counsel may assert that such interest is not an item of tax preference for the purposes of the alternative minimum tax or is exempt from certain state or local taxes. There is no assurance that the applicable taxing authority will agree with this opinion. In the event, for example, the IRS determines that an issuer does not comply with relevant tax requirements, interest payments from a security could become federally taxable, possibly retroactively to the date the security was issued. As a shareholder of the Fund, you may be required to file an amended tax return as a result, reporting such income as taxable.

For more information about the economic conditions, legal matters and key risks associated with investments in certain states, see Appendix D.

Participation Interests

Participation interests (also called pass-through certificates or securities) represent an interest in a pool of debt obligations, such as municipal bonds or notes, that have been “packaged” by an intermediary, such as a bank or broker/dealer. Participation interests typically are issued by partnerships or trusts through which a Fund receives principal and interest payments that are passed through to the holder of the participation interest from

 

46


Table of Contents

the payments made on the underlying debt obligations. The purchaser of a participation interest receives an undivided interest in the underlying debt obligations. The issuers of the underlying debt obligations make interest and principal payments to the intermediary, as an initial purchaser, which are passed through to purchasers in the secondary market, such as a Fund. Mortgage-backed securities are a common type of participation interest. Participation interests may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in- kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments — Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Loan participations also are a type of participation interest. Loan participations are interests in loans that are administered by a lending bank or agent for a syndicate of lending banks and sold by the bank or syndicate members.

Investing in participation interests is subject to certain risks. Participation interests generally are subject to the credit risk associated with the underlying borrowers. If the underlying borrower defaults, a Fund may be subject to delays, expenses and risks that are greater than those that would have been involved if a Fund had purchased a direct obligation of the borrower. A Fund also may be deemed a creditor of the lending bank or syndicate members and be subject to the risk that the lending bank or syndicate members may become insolvent.

Preferred Stock

Preferred stock represents units of ownership of a corporation that frequently have dividends that are set at a specified rate. Preferred stock has preference over common stock in the payment of dividends and the liquidation of assets. Preferred stock shares some of the characteristics of both debt and equity. Preferred stock ordinarily does not carry voting rights. Most preferred stock is cumulative; if dividends are passed (i.e., not paid for any reason), they accumulate and must be paid before common stock dividends. Participating preferred stock entitles its holders to share in profits above and beyond the declared dividend, along with common shareholders, as distinguished from nonparticipating preferred stock, which is limited to the stipulated dividend. Convertible preferred stock is exchangeable for a given number of shares of common stock and thus tends to be more volatile than nonconvertible preferred stock, which generally behaves more like a fixed income bond. Preferred stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments — Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Auction preferred stock (APS) is a type of adjustable-rate preferred stock with a dividend determined periodically in a Dutch auction process by corporate bidders. Shares typically are bought and sold at face values generally ranging from $100,000 to $500,000 per share.

In addition to reinvestment risk if interest rates fall, some specific risks with regard to APS include:

 

   

Failed auction: A breakdown of the auction process can occur. In the event that the process fails, the rate is reset at the maximum applicable rate, which is usually described in the prospectuses and typically is influenced by the issuer’s credit rating. In a failed auction, current shareholders generally are unable to sell some, or all, of the shares when the auction is completed. Typically, the liquidity for APS that have experienced a failed auction becomes very limited. If a failed auction were to occur, the shareholder generally would hold his or her shares until the next auction. Should there not be subsequent auctions that “cure” the failed process, the shareholder may: (1) hold the APS in anticipation of a refinancing by the issuer that would cause the APS to be called, or (2) hold securities either indefinitely or in anticipation of the development of a secondary market.

 

   

Early call risk: APS generally is redeemable at any time, usually upon notice, at the issuer’s option, at par plus accrued dividends.

 

47


Table of Contents

 

Investing in preferred stock is subject to certain risks. For example, stock market risk is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when prices generally rise and periods when prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and decline based on factors specific to each corporation, such as changes in earnings or management.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular company. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price fluctuations than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, are more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Stocks of these companies may have a higher potential for gains but also are subject to greater risk of loss.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably affect, an industry, the prices of the stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the value of those companies’ stock to decline.

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

Private placement securities are securities that have been privately placed and are not registered under the 1933 Act. They are eligible for sale only to certain eligible investors. Private placements often may offer attractive opportunities for investment not otherwise available on the open market. Private placement and other “restricted” securities often cannot be sold to the public without registration under the 1933 Act or the availability of an exemption from registration (such as Rules 144 or 144A), or they are “not readily marketable” because they are subject to other legal or contractual delays in or restrictions on resale. Asset-backed securities, common stock, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, preferred stock and other types of equity and debt instruments may be privately placed or restricted securities.

Private placements typically may be sold only to qualified institutional buyers (or, in the case of the initial sale of certain securities, such as those issued in collateralized debt obligations or collateralized loan obligations, to accredited investors (as defined in Rule 501(a) under the 1933 Act), or in a privately negotiated transaction or to a limited number of purchasers, or in limited quantities after they have been held for a specified period of time and other conditions are met pursuant to an exemption from registration.

Investing in private placement and other restricted securities is subject to certain risks. Private placements may be considered illiquid securities. Private placements typically are subject to restrictions on resale as a matter of contract or under federal securities laws. Because there may be relatively few potential purchasers for such securities, especially under adverse market or economic conditions or in the event of adverse changes in the financial condition of the issuer, a Fund could find it more difficult to sell such securities when it may be advisable to do so or it may be able to sell such securities only at prices lower than if such securities were more widely held. At times, it also may be more difficult to determine the fair value of such securities for purposes of computing a Fund’s net asset value due to the absence of a trading market.

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

REITs are entities that either own properties or make construction or mortgage loans and also may include operating or finance companies. An equity REIT generally holds equity positions in real estate and seeks to

 

48


Table of Contents

provide its shareholders with income from the leasing of its properties and with capital gains from any sales of properties. A mortgage REIT generally specializes in lending money to owners of properties and passes through any interest income it may earn to its shareholders.

Partnership units of real estate and other types of companies sometimes are organized as master limited partnerships in which ownership interests are publicly traded. Master limited partnerships often own several properties or businesses (or directly own interests) that are related to real estate development and the oil and gas industries, but they also may finance motion pictures, research and development and other projects.

REITs are subject to certain risks associated with direct ownership of real estate, including, for example, declines in the value of real estate, risks related to general and local economic conditions, overbuilding and increased competition, increases in property taxes and operating expenses, and variations in rental income. REITs also may be subject to interest rate risk. In general, increases in interest rates will decrease the value of high-yield securities and increase the costs of obtaining financing, which could decrease the value of a REIT’s investments. In addition, equity REITs may be affected by changes in the value of the underlying property owned by the REITs, while mortgage REITs may be affected by the quality of credit extended. Both equity and mortgage REITs are dependent upon management skills. REITs also may be subject to heavy cash flow dependency, defaults by borrowers, and the possibility of failing to qualify for preferential tax treatment under the Code, which could adversely affect dividend payments. REITs also may not be diversified.

Investing in master limited partnerships generally is subject to the risks applicable to investing in a partnership as opposed to a corporation, which may include fewer protections afforded to investors. Additional risks include those associated with the specific industries in which a master limited partnership invests, such as the risks associated with investing in the real estate or oil and gas industries.

Repurchase Agreements

Repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund acquires a security for a relatively short period of time subject to the obligation of a seller to repurchase and a Fund to resell such security at a fixed time and price (representing a Fund’s cost plus interest). Repurchase agreements also may be viewed as loans made by a Fund that are collateralized by the securities subject to repurchase. A Fund typically will enter into repurchase agreements only with commercial banks, registered broker/dealers and the Fixed Income Clearing Corporation. Such transactions are monitored to ensure that the value of the underlying securities will be at least equal at all times to the total amount of the repurchase obligation, including any accrued interest. Repurchase agreements generally are subject to counterparty risk.

If a counterparty defaults, a Fund could realize a loss on the sale of the underlying security to the extent that the proceeds of the sale are less than the resale price provided in the repurchase agreement including interest. In the event that a counterparty fails to perform because it is insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund’s right to take possession of the underlying securities would be subject to applicable insolvency law and procedure, including an automatic stay (which would preclude immediate enforcement of a Fund’s rights) and exemptions thereto (which would permit a Fund to take possession of the underlying securities or to void a repurchase agreement altogether). Since it is possible that an exemption from the automatic stay would not be available, a Fund might be prevented from immediately enforcing its rights against the counterparty. Accordingly, if a counterparty becomes insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund may incur delays in or be prevented from liquidating the underlying securities and could experience losses, including the possible decline in value of the underlying securities during the period in which a Fund seeks to enforce its rights thereto, possible subnormal levels of income or lack of access to income during such time, as well as the costs incurred in enforcing a Fund’s rights. For example, if a Fund enters into a repurchase agreement with a broker that becomes insolvent, it is possible for the Securities Investor Protection Corporation (SIPC) to institute a liquidation proceeding in federal court against the broker counterparty which could lead to a foreclosure by SIPC of the underlying securities or SIPC may stay, or preclude, a Fund’s ability under contract to terminate the repurchase agreement.

 

49


Table of Contents

 

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

Reverse repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund sells a security subject to the obligation of a buyer to resell and a Fund to repurchase such security at a fixed time and price. Reverse repurchase agreements also may be viewed as borrowings made by a Fund.

Reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase under the agreement may decline below the repurchase price. In the event the buyer of securities under a reverse repurchase agreement files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the agreement may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, reverse repurchase agreements are techniques involving leverage, and are subject to asset coverage requirements. Under the requirements of the 1940 Act, a Fund is required to maintain an asset coverage (including the proceeds of the borrowings) of at least 300% of all borrowings.

Standby Commitments

Standby commitments are securities under which a purchaser, usually a bank or broker/dealer, agrees to purchase, for a fee, an amount of a Fund’s municipal obligations. The amount payable by a bank or broker/dealer to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment typically will be substantially the same as the value of the underlying municipal securities. A Fund may pay for standby commitments either separately in cash or by paying a higher price for portfolio securities that are acquired subject to such a commitment.

Using standby commitments is subject to certain risks. Standby commitments are subject to the risk that a counterparty will not fulfill its obligation to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment.

Stripped Securities

Stripped securities are securities that evidence ownership in either the future interest or principal payments on an instrument. There are many different types and variations of stripped securities. For example, Separate Trading of Registered Interest and Principal Securities (STRIPS), can be component parts of a U.S. Treasury security where the principal and interest components are traded independently through DTC, a clearing agency registered pursuant to Section 17A of the 1934 Act and created to hold securities for its participants, and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between participants through electronic computerized book-entries, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of certificates. Treasury Investor Growth Receipts (TIGERs) are U.S. Treasury securities stripped by brokers. Stripped mortgage-backed securities, or SMBS, also can be issued by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Stripped securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

SMBS usually are structured with two or more classes that receive different proportions of the interest and principal distributions from a pool of mortgage-backed assets. Common types of SMBS will be structured so that one class receives some of the interest and most of the principal from the mortgage-backed assets, while another class receives most of the interest and the remainder of the principal.

Investing in stripped securities is subject to certain risks. If the underlying obligations experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, a Fund may fail fully to recoup its initial investment in such securities. The market value of the class consisting primarily or entirely of principal payments can be especially volatile in response to changes in interest rates. The rates of return on a class of SMBS that receives all or most of the interest are generally higher than prevailing market rates of return on other mortgage-backed obligations because their cash flow patterns also are volatile and there is a greater risk that the initial investment will not be recouped fully.

 

50


Table of Contents

 

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

U.S. Government obligations include U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government or by various instrumentalities which have been established or sponsored by the U.S. Government. U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government differ in their interest rates, maturities and time of issuance, as well as with respect to whether they are guaranteed by the U.S. Government. U.S. Government and related obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments — Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

U.S. Government obligations also include senior unsecured debt securities issued between October 14, 2008 and June 30, 2009 by eligible issuers (including U.S. depository institutions insured by the FDIC (and certain affiliates), U.S. bank holding companies and certain U.S. savings and loan holding companies) that are guaranteed by the FDIC under its Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (the “TLGP”). The FDIC’s guarantee under the TLGP will expire upon the earlier of (i) maturity of such security or (ii) June 30, 2012. It is the view of the FDIC and the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission that any debt security that is guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP and that has a maturity that ends on or before June 30, 2012 would be a security exempt from registration under Section 3(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933 because such security would be fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the FDIC.

Investing in securities guaranteed under the TLGP is subject to certain risks. Given that there is a limited track record for securities guaranteed under the TLGP, it is uncertain whether such securities will continue to trade in line with recent experience in relation to treasury and government agency securities in terms of yield spread and the volatility of such spread and it is uncertain how such securities will trade in the secondary market and whether that market will be liquid or illiquid. The TLGP is a new program that is subject to change. In order to collect from the FDIC under the TLGP, a claims process must be followed. Failure to follow the claims process could result in a loss to the right to payment under the guarantee. In addition, guarantee payments by the FDIC under the TLGP may be delayed.

Investing in U.S. Government and related obligations is subject to certain risks. While U.S. Treasury obligations are backed by the “full faith and credit” of the U.S. Government, securities issued or guaranteed by federal agencies and U.S. Government-sponsored instrumentalities may or may not be backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. These securities may be supported by the ability to borrow from the U.S. Treasury or only by the credit of the issuing agency or instrumentality and, as a result, may be subject to greater credit risk than securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Treasury. Obligations of U.S. Government agencies, authorities, instrumentalities and sponsored enterprises historically have involved limited risk of loss of principal if held to maturity. However, no assurance can be given that the U.S. Government would provide financial support to any of these entities if it is not obligated to do so by law.

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

Variable- and floating-rate obligations provide for periodic adjustments in the interest rate and, under certain circumstances, varying principal amounts. Unlike a fixed interest rate, a variable, or floating, rate is one that rises and declines based on the movement of an underlying index of interest rates and may pay interest at rates that are adjusted periodically according to a specified formula. Asset-backed securities, bank obligations, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as variable- and floating-rate obligations.

Investing in variable- and floating-rate obligations is subject to certain risks. Variable- and floating-rate obligations may involve direct lending arrangements between the purchaser and the issuer and there may be no active secondary market, making it difficult to resell such obligations to a third party. Variable- and floating-rate

 

51


Table of Contents

obligations also may be subject to interest rate and credit risks. Changes in interest rates can affect the rate of return on such obligations. If an issuer of a variable- or floating-rate obligation defaults, a Fund could sustain a loss to the extent of such default.

Warrants and Rights

Warrants and rights are types of securities that give a holder a right to purchase shares of common stock. Warrants usually are issued together with a bond or preferred stock and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock at a specified price typically for a period of years. Rights usually have a specified purchase price that is lower than the current market price and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock typically for a period of only weeks. Warrants may be used to enhance the marketability of a bond or preferred stock.

Warrants and rights may be subject to the risk that the securities could lose value. There also is the risk that the potential exercise price may exceed the market price of the warrants or rights, such as when there is no movement in the market price or the market price of such securities declines.

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the purchase or sale of securities by a Fund, with payment and delivery taking place in the future. When engaging in when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions, a Fund typically will hold cash or liquid securities in a segregated account in an amount equal to or greater than the purchase price. The payment obligation and, if applicable, the interest rate that will be received on the securities, are fixed at the time that a Fund agrees to purchase the securities. A Fund generally will enter into when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions only with the intention of completing such transactions. However, the Adviser may determine not to complete a transaction if it deems it appropriate. In such cases, a Fund may realize short-term gains or losses.

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the risks that the securities purchased may fall in value by the time they actually are issued or that the other party may fail to honor the contract terms. A Fund that invests in delayed delivery securities may rely on a third party to complete the transaction. Failure by a third party to deliver a security purchased on a delayed delivery basis may result in a financial loss to a Fund or the loss of an opportunity to make an alternative investment.

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

Zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities are types of debt instruments that do not necessarily make payments of interest in fixed amounts or at fixed intervals. Asset-backed securities, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities.

Zero-coupon securities do not pay interest on a current basis but instead accrue interest over the life of the security. These securities include, among others, zero-coupon bonds, which either may be issued at a discount by a corporation or government entity or may be created by a brokerage firm when it strips the coupons from a bond or note and then sells the bond or note and the coupon separately. This technique is used frequently with U.S. Treasury bonds, and zero-coupon securities are marketed under such names as CATS (Certificate of Accrual on Treasury Securities), TIGERs or STRIPS. Zero-coupon bonds also are issued by municipalities. Buying a municipal zero-coupon bond frees its purchaser of the obligation to pay regular federal income tax on imputed interest, since the interest is exempt for regular federal income tax purposes. Zero-coupon certificates of deposit and zero-coupon mortgages are generally structured in the same fashion as zero-coupon bonds; the certificate of deposit holder or mortgage holder receives face value at maturity and no payments until then.

 

52


Table of Contents

 

Pay-in-kind securities normally give the issuer an option to pay cash at a coupon payment date or to give the holder of the security a similar security with the same coupon rate and a face value equal to the amount of the coupon payment that would have been made.

Step-coupon securities trade at a discount from their face value and pay coupon interest. The coupon rate is paid according to a schedule for a series of periods, typically lower for an initial period and then increasing to a higher coupon rate thereafter. The discount from the face amount or par value depends on the time remaining until cash payments begin, prevailing interest rates, liquidity of the security and the perceived credit quality of the issue.

Zero-coupon, step-coupon and pay-in-kind securities holders generally have substantially all the rights and privileges of holders of the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations. Holders of these securities have the right upon default on the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations to proceed directly and individually against the issuer and are not required to act in concert with other holders of such securities.

Investing in zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities is subject to certain risks, including that market prices of zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities generally are more volatile than the prices of securities that pay interest periodically and in cash, and are likely to respond to changes in interest rates to a greater degree than other types of debt securities.

Because zero-coupon securities bear no interest, they are volatile. Since zero-coupon bondholders do not receive interest payments, zero-coupon securities fall more dramatically than bonds paying interest on a current basis when interest rates rise. However, when interest rates fall, zero-coupon securities rise more rapidly in value than interest paying bonds.

Borrowings

Each Fund has a fundamental policy with respect to borrowing that can be found under the heading About the Funds’ Investments — Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies. Specifically, each Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds. In general, pursuant to the 1940 Act, a Fund may borrow money only from banks in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings). Any borrowings that come to exceed this amount must be reduced within three days (not including Sundays and holidays) to the extent necessary to comply with the 33 1/3% limitation.

The Funds participate in a committed line of credit (Line of Credit). Any advance under the Line of Credit is contemplated primarily for temporary or emergency purposes, including the meeting of redemption requests that otherwise might require the untimely sale of portfolio securities.

Pursuant to an exemptive order from the SEC, a Fund may, subject to certain conditions, borrow money from or lend money to other funds in the Columbia Funds Family or any other registered investment company advised by the Adviser or its affiliates for temporary emergency purposes in order to facilitate redemption requests, or for other purposes consistent with Fund investment policies and restrictions. All loans are set at an interest rate between the rates charged on overnight repurchase agreements and short-term bank loans.

Short Sales

A Fund may sometimes sell securities short when it owns an equal amount of such securities as those securities sold short. This is a technique known as selling short “against the box.” If a Fund makes a short sale “against the box,” it would not immediately deliver the securities sold and would not receive the proceeds from the sale. The seller is said to have a short position in the securities sold until it delivers the securities sold, at

 

53


Table of Contents

which time it receives the proceeds of the sale. To secure its obligation to deliver securities sold short, a Fund will deposit in escrow in a separate account with the custodian an equal amount of the securities sold short or securities convertible into or exchangeable for such securities. A Fund can close out its short position by purchasing and delivering an equal amount of the securities sold short, rather than by delivering securities already held by a Fund, because a Fund might want to continue to receive interest and dividend payments on securities in its portfolio that are convertible into the securities sold short.

Short sales “against the box” entail many of the same risks and considerations described above regarding short sales not “against the box.” However, when a Fund sells short “against the box” it typically limits the amount of securities that it has leveraged. A Fund’s decision to make a short sale “against the box” may be a technique to hedge against market risks when the Adviser believes that the price of a security may decline, causing a decline in the value of a security owned by a Fund or a security convertible into or exchangeable for such security. In such case, any future losses in a Fund’s long position would be reduced by a gain in the short position. The extent to which such gains or losses in the long position are reduced will depend upon the amount of securities sold short relative to the amount of the securities a Fund owns, either directly or indirectly, and, in the case where a Fund owns convertible securities, changes in the investment values or conversion premiums of such securities. Short sales may have adverse tax consequences to a Fund and its shareholders.

Subject to its fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies, a Fund may engage in short sales that are not “against the box,” which are sales by a Fund of securities or commodity futures contracts that it does not own in hopes of purchasing the same security at a later date at a lower price. The technique is also used to protect a profit in a long-term position in a security or commodity futures contract. To make delivery to the buyer, a Fund must borrow or purchase the security. If borrowed, a Fund is then obligated to replace the security borrowed from the third party, so a Fund must purchase the security at the market price at a later time. If the price of the security has increased during this time, then a Fund will incur a loss equal to the increase in price of the security from the time of the short sale plus any premiums and interest paid to the third party. (Until the security is replaced, a Fund is required to pay to the lender amounts equal to any dividends or interest which accrue during the period of the loan. To borrow the security, a Fund also may be required to pay a premium, which would increase the cost of the security sold. The proceeds of the short sale will be retained by the broker, to the extent necessary to meet the margin requirements, until the short position is closed out.)

Short sales by a Fund that are not made “against the box” create opportunities to increase a Fund’s return but, at the same time, involve specific risk considerations and may be considered a speculative technique. Because a Fund in effect profits from a decline in the price of the securities sold short without the need to invest the full purchase price of the securities on the date of the short sale, a Fund’s NAV per share tends to increase more when the securities it has sold short decrease in value, and to decrease more when the securities it has sold short increase in value, than if it had not engaged in such short sales. The amount of any gain will be decreased, and the amount of any loss increased, by the amount of any premium, dividends or interest a Fund may be required to pay in connection with the short sale. Short sales could potentially involve unlimited loss, as the market price of securities sold short may continually increase, although a Fund can mitigate any such losses by replacing the securities sold short. Under adverse market conditions, a Fund might have difficulty purchasing securities to meet its short sale delivery obligations, and might have to sell portfolio securities to raise the capital necessary to meet its short sale obligations at a time when fundamental investment considerations would not favor such sales. There is also the risk that the third party to the short sale may fail to honor its contract terms, causing a loss to a Fund.

A Fund’s successful use of short sales also will be subject to the ability of the Adviser to predict movements in the directions of the relevant market. A Fund therefore bears the risk that the Adviser will incorrectly predict future price directions. In addition, if a Fund sells a security short, and that security’s price goes up, a Fund will have to make up the margin on its open position (i.e., purchase more securities on the market to cover the position). It may be unable to do so and thus its position may not be closed out. There can be no assurance that a Fund will not incur significant losses in such a case.

 

54


Table of Contents

 

In the view of the SEC, a short sale involves the creation of a “senior security” as such term is defined in the 1940 Act, unless the sale is “against the box” and the securities sold short are placed in a segregated account (not with the broker), or unless a Fund’s obligation to deliver the securities sold short is “covered” by placing in a segregated account (not with the broker) cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities in an amount equal to the difference between the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale and any such collateral required to be deposited with a broker in connection with the sale (not including the proceeds from the short sale), which difference is adjusted daily for changes in the value of the securities sold short. The total value of the cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities deposited with the broker and otherwise segregated may not at any time be less than the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale.

Lending Securities

Securities lending refers to the lending of the Fund’s portfolio securities. Subject to its investment policies described above and in the prospectuses, the Fund may make secured loans of its portfolio securities to broker/dealers and other institutional investors. Securities loans by the Fund are made pursuant to agreements that require that loans be secured continuously by collateral in cash. The Fund retains all or a portion of the income received on investment of cash collateral. A borrower will pay to the Fund an amount equal to any dividends or interest received on securities loaned, but the borrower typically will receive a portion of the income earned on investments of cash collateral. Although voting rights, or rights to consent, with respect to loaned securities pass to a borrower, the Fund retains the right to call the loans at any time on reasonable notice, and may do so in order to vote upon matters affecting, or to sell, the loaned securities.

The Fund typically invests the cash collateral it receives in connection with its securities lending program directly or indirectly in high quality, short-term investments. The Fund may invest some or all of such cash collateral in one or more pooled investment vehicles, including, among other vehicles, money market funds managed by the Fund’s securities lending agent or its affiliates. The securities lending agent shares in any income resulting from the investment of such cash collateral, and an affiliate of the securities lending agent receives asset-based fees for the management of such pooled investment vehicles, which may create a conflict of interest between the securities lending agent (or its affiliate) and the Fund with respect to the management of such cash collateral.

Engaging in securities lending is subject to certain risks, including counterparty risk, which is the risk that the counterparty to a transaction could default. There also is a risk of possible delay in the recovery of loaned securities or possible loss of rights in the collateral if a borrower fails financially.

Portfolio Turnover

A change in the securities held by a Fund is known as “portfolio turnover.” High portfolio turnover (e.g., over 100%) involves correspondingly greater expenses to the Fund, including brokerage commissions or dealer mark-ups and other transaction costs on the sale of securities and reinvestments in other securities. Such sales may also result in adverse tax consequences to a Fund’s shareholders. The trading costs and tax effects associated with portfolio turnover may adversely affect a Fund’s performance.

For each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate, see the Fees and Expenses of the Fund — Portfolio Turnover section in the prospectuses for that Fund.

In any particular year, market conditions may result in greater rates than are presently anticipated. The rate of a Fund’s turnover may vary significantly from time to time depending on the volatility of economic and market conditions.

 

55


Table of Contents

 

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

The Board has adopted policies and procedures with respect to the disclosure of each Fund’s portfolio holdings. These policies and procedures are designed to ensure that disclosure of information regarding a Fund’s portfolio securities is in the best interests of Fund shareholders and to address conflicts between the interests of Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Fund, on the other. These policies and procedures provide that a Fund’s portfolio holdings information generally may not be disclosed to any party prior to the earlier of: (i) the business day next following the posting of such information on the Columbia Funds’ website, if applicable, or (ii) the time a Fund discloses the information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information. Certain limited exceptions that have been approved consistent with the policies and procedures are described below. The Board is updated as needed regarding compliance with these policies and procedures. The policies and procedures prohibit the Adviser and a Fund’s other service providers from entering into any agreement to disclose Fund portfolio holdings information in exchange for any form of consideration. The same policies and procedures apply to all categories of Columbia Funds and include some variations tailored to the different categories of Columbia Funds. Accordingly, some of the provisions described below do not apply to the Columbia Funds covered by this SAI. The Adviser also has adopted policies and procedures to monitor for compliance with these portfolio holdings disclosure policies and procedures.

Public Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings are currently disclosed to the public through required filings with the SEC and on the Columbia Funds’ website. This information is available on the Columbia Funds’ website as described below.

 

   

For equity, convertible, balanced and asset allocation Columbia Funds, other than small cap and specialty Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 15 calendar days after such month-end.

 

   

For small cap and specialty Columbia Funds and those Columbia Funds that are sub-advised by Marsico and Brandes, subadvisers for certain Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such month-end.

 

   

For fixed-income funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a calendar quarter-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such quarter-end.

 

   

For money market funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of month-end are posted on the Columbia Funds’ website on a monthly basis, approximately five business days after such month-end. Commencing with the month-end holdings as of September 2010 and thereafter, such month-end holdings will be continuously available on the website for at least six months, together with a link to an SEC webpage where a user of the website may obtain access to the fund’s most recent 12 months of publicly available filings on Form N-MFP. Additionally, as of September 2010 and thereafter, money market fund portfolio holdings information posted on the website will, at minimum, include with respect to each holding, the name of the issuer, the category of investment (e.g., Treasury debt, government agency debt, asset backed commercial paper, structured investment vehicle note), the CUSIP number (if any), the principal amount, the maturity date (as determined under Rule 2a-7 for purposes of calculating weighted average maturity), the final maturity date (if different from the maturity date previously described), coupon or yield and the amortized cost value. The money market funds will also disclose on the website the overall weighted average maturity and weighted average life maturity of a holding.

The Adviser makes publicly available information regarding certain Columbia Fund’s largest five to fifteen holdings, as a percent of the market value of the Columbia Funds’ portfolios as of a month-end. This holdings information is made publicly available through the website generally no earlier than fifteen (15) days following the month-end.

 

56


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser may also disclose more current portfolio holdings information as of specified dates on the Columbia Funds’ website.

The scope of the information that is made available on the Columbia Funds’ website pursuant to the Columbia Funds’ policies relating to a Columbia Fund’s portfolio may change from time to time without prior notice. The Columbia Funds file their portfolio holdings with the SEC for each fiscal quarter on Form N-CSR (with respect to each annual period and semi-annual period) and Form N-Q (with respect to the first and third quarters of each Columbia Fund’s fiscal year). Shareholders may obtain each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, a link to which is provided on the Columbia Funds’ website. In addition, each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings may be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s public reference room in Washington, D.C. You may call the SEC at 202.551.8090 for information about the SEC’s website or the operation of the public reference room.

The Columbia Funds, the Adviser and their affiliates may include portfolio holdings information that already has been made public through a website posting or SEC filing in marketing literature and other communications to shareholders, advisors or other parties, provided that the information is disclosed no earlier than the business day after the date the information is disclosed publicly on the Columbia Funds’ website or no earlier than the time a Columbia Fund files such information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information.

Other Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ policies and procedures provide that no disclosures of the Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings may be made prior to the portfolio holdings information being made public unless (i) the Columbia Funds have a legitimate business purpose for making such disclosure, (ii) the Columbia Funds’ President authorizes such non-public disclosure of information, and (iii) the party receiving the non-public information enters into an appropriate confidentiality agreement or is otherwise subject to a confidentiality obligation.

In determining the existence of a legitimate business purpose for making portfolio disclosures, the following factors, among others, are considered: (i) any prior disclosure must be consistent with the anti-fraud provisions of the federal securities laws and the fiduciary duties of the Adviser; (ii) any conflicts of interest between the interests of Columbia Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Columbia Fund, on the other; and (iii) any prior disclosure to a third party, although subject to a confidentiality agreement, would not make conduct lawful that otherwise is unlawful.

In addition, the Columbia Funds periodically disclose their portfolio information on a confidential basis to various service providers that require such information to assist the Columbia Funds with their day-to-day business affairs. In addition to the Adviser and its affiliates, these service providers include each Columbia Fund’s subadviser(s) (if any), the Columbia Funds’ custodian, sub-custodians, independent registered public accounting firm, legal counsel, financial printers, proxy solicitor and proxy voting service provider, as well as ratings agencies that maintain ratings on certain Columbia Funds. These service providers are required to keep such information confidential, and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information except as necessary in providing services to the Columbia Funds. The Columbia Funds also may disclose portfolio holdings information to broker/dealers and certain other entities in connection with potential transactions and management of the Columbia Funds, provided that reasonable precautions, including limitations on the scope of the portfolio holdings information disclosed, are taken to avoid any potential misuse of the disclosed information.

Each Columbia Fund’s Board has adopted policies to ensure that the Columbia Fund’s holdings information is only disclosed in accordance with these policies. Before any selective disclosure of holdings information is permitted, the person seeking to disclose such holdings information must submit a written request to the Portfolio Holdings Committee (“PHC”). The PHC is comprised of members from the Adviser’s legal department, the

 

57


Table of Contents

Adviser’s compliance department, and the Columbia Funds’ President. The PHC has been authorized by each Columbia Fund’s Board to perform an initial review of requests for disclosure of holdings information to evaluate whether there is a legitimate business purpose for selective disclosure, whether selective disclosure is in the best interests of a fund and its shareholders, to consider any potential conflicts of interest between the fund, the investment adviser, and its affiliates, and to safeguard against improper use of holdings information. Factors considered in this analysis are whether the recipient has agreed to or has a duty to keep the holdings information confidential and whether risks have been mitigated such that the recipient has agreed or has a duty to use the holdings information only as necessary to effectuate the purpose for which selective disclosure was authorized, including a duty not to trade on such information. Before portfolio holdings may be selectively disclosed, requests approved by the PHC must also be authorized by either the Columbia Fund’s President, Chief Compliance Officer or General Counsel or their respective designees. On at least an annual basis, the PHC reviews the approved recipients of selective disclosure and may require a resubmission of the request, in order to re-authorize certain ongoing arrangements. These procedures are intended to be reasonably designed to protect the confidentiality of fund holdings information and to prohibit their release to individual investors, institutional investors, intermediaries that distribute the Columbia Funds’ shares, and other parties, until such holdings information is made public or unless such persons have been authorized to receive such holdings information on a selective basis, as set forth above.

The Columbia Funds currently have ongoing arrangements with certain approved recipients with respect to the disclosure of portfolio holdings information prior to such information being made public. Portfolio holdings information disclosed to such recipients is current as of the time of its disclosure, is disclosed to each recipient solely for purposes consistent with the services described below and has been authorized by the Columbia Funds’ President. These special arrangements are described in the table below.

Ongoing Portfolio Holdings Disclosure Arrangements

 

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
  

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS
ON USE OF INFORMATION

  

FREQUENCY
OF
DISCLOSURE

Standard & Poor’s    None    Use to maintain ratings for certain money market funds.    Weekly
InvestorTools, Inc.    None    Access granted solely for the purpose of testing back office conversion of trading systems.    Real time
ING Insurance Company    None    Access granted for specific Columbia Funds for ING’s creation of client/shareholder materials. ING may not distribute materials until the holdings information is made public.    Quarterly
Glass-Lewis & Co.    None    Access in connection with testing the firm’s proxy services.    Daily
CMS Bondedge    None    Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with application used by the Adviser’s Fixed Income Portfolio Management team as an analytical and trading tool.    Ad hoc

 

58


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
  

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS
ON USE OF INFORMATION

  

FREQUENCY
OF
DISCLOSURE

Linedata Services, Inc.    None    Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with the software for the LongView Trade Order Management System.    Ad hoc
JP Morgan    None    Access to provide the Adviser’s High Yield portfolio management team with peer group analysis reports for purposes of analyzing the portfolio.    Monthly
Malaspina Communications    None    Use to facilitate writing, publishing and mailing Columbia Fund shareholder reports and communications including shareholder letters and management’s discussion of Columbia Fund performance.    Quarterly
Evare LLP    None    Use for standardizing and reformatting data according to the Adviser’s specifications for use in the reconciliation process.    Daily
FactSet Research Systems, Inc.    None    Use for provision of quantitative analytics, charting and fundamental data to the Adviser and Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
RR Donnelley/WE Andrews    None    Access as printers for the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs, fact sheets and brochures.    Monthly
Merrill Corporation    None    Use to provide fulfillment of the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs and sales materials.    Monthly
Citigroup    None    Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with Yield Book, an analytic software program that the Adviser uses to perform ongoing risk analysis and management of certain fixed income Columbia Funds and fixed income separately managed accounts.    Daily

 

59


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
  

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS
ON USE OF INFORMATION

  

FREQUENCY
OF
DISCLOSURE

Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS)    None    Proxy voting administration and research on proxy matters utilized by MacKay Shields LLC, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
Cogent Consulting LLC    None    Utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds, to facilitate the evaluation of commission rates and to provide flexible commission reporting.    Daily
Moody’s    None    Ongoing portfolio surveillance for ratings it maintains on certain money market funds.    Monthly
Kynex    None    Use to provide portfolio attribution reports.    Daily
Bowne & Co.    None    Use for printing of the following materials: prospectuses, supplements and SAIs.    Monthly/ quarterly
Bloomberg    None    Use for portfolio analytics.    Daily
Barclays Point    None    Use for analytics including risk and attribution assessment.    Daily
Broadridge Financial Solutions, Inc.    None    Proxy voting and research utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Macgregor)    None    Order management system utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds that stores trading data and is used for trading and compliance purposes.    Ad hoc
Advent/AXP    None    Portfolio accounting system utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds, for both portfolio accounting and internal recordkeeping purposes.    Ad hoc
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Plexus Group)    None    Evaluation and assessment of trading activity, execution and practices by the Adviser.    Five days after quarter-end
BANA and State Street    None    Credit analysis performed by lenders.    Ad hoc
State Street    None    Use to provide custodian services.    Real time
Lipper    None    Use to create metrics for board and executive management reporting, product and marketing analysis, and fund performance.    Daily
Morningstar, Inc.    None    Use for independent research and ranking of Columbia Funds.    Daily

 

60


Table of Contents

 

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly, RiverSource Investments, LLC) (the Adviser) is the investment adviser and administrator of the Funds. The Adviser is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial. Ameriprise Financial is located at 1099 Ameriprise Financial Center, Minneapolis, MN 55474. The Adviser is located at 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110. Prior to May 1, 2010, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (the Previous Adviser), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Bank of America, was the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator.

The International Value Fund is a Feeder Fund and does not pay investment advisory fees because it invests all of its assets in Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. The Adviser earns its fee as the investment adviser to the Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. See the Management of the Fund – Primary Services Providers section in the International Value Fund’s prospectus.

Services Provided

Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, the Adviser has contracted to furnish each Fund with investment research and advice. For these services, each Fund pays a monthly fee to the Adviser based on the average of the daily closing value of the total net assets of a Fund for such month. Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, any liability of the Adviser to the Trust, a Fund and/or its shareholders is limited to situations involving the Adviser’s own willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence in the performance of its duties or reckless disregard of its obligations and duties.

The Investment Management Services Agreement may be terminated with respect to a Fund at any time on 60 days’ written notice by the Adviser or by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund. The Investment Management Services Agreement will automatically terminate upon any assignment thereof, will continue in effect for two years from May 1, 2010 and thereafter will continue from year to year with respect to a Fund only so long as such continuance is approved at least annually (i) by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund and (ii) by vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as such term is defined in the 1940 Act) of the Adviser or the Trust, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval.

The Adviser pays all compensation of the Trustees and officers of the Trust who are employees of the Adviser, except for the Chief Compliance Officer, a portion of whose salary is paid by the Columbia Funds. Except to the extent expressly assumed by the Adviser and except to the extent required by law to be paid or reimbursed by the Adviser, the Adviser does not have a duty to pay any Fund operating expense incurred in the organization and operation of a Fund, including, but not limited to, auditing, legal, custodial, investor servicing and shareholder reporting expenses. The Trust pays the cost of printing and mailing Fund prospectuses to shareholders.

The Adviser, at its own expense, provides office space, facilities and supplies, equipment and personnel for the performance of its functions under each Fund’s Investment Management Services Agreement.

Advisory Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

Each Fund pays the Adviser an annual fee for its investment advisory services, as set forth in the Investment Management Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Fees and Expenses of the Fund/Portfolio Annual Fund/Portfolio Operating Expenses in each Fund’s prospectuses. The fee is calculated as a percentage of the average daily net assets of each Fund and is paid monthly. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor and/or to selling and/or servicing agents for services they provide.

 

61


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser receives a monthly investment advisory fee based on each Fund’s average daily net assets at the following annual rates:

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
and up to
$1 billion
    In excess
of $1
billion
and up to
$1.5 billion
    In excess
of $1.5
billion
and up to
$3 billion
    In excess
of $3
billion
and up to
$6 billion
    In excess
of $6
billion
 

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Global Value Fund

     0.90     0.85     0.80     0.75     0.73     0.71

International Value Fund*

     0.85     0.80     0.75     0.70     0.68     0.66

Large Cap Core Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.50     0.45     0.43     0.41

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

     0.35     0.30     0.25     0.20     0.18     0.16

Large Cap Value Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.43     0.43     0.43     0.41

Marsico 21st Century Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.58     0.56

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.58     0.56

Marsico Growth Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.58     0.56

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.53     0.51

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Total Return Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     0.40     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

 

* Investment advisory fees are paid by Columbia International Value Master Portfolio, the Master Portfolio of the Feeder Fund.

 

Fund

   All assets  

Asset Allocation Fund II

     0.60

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     0.00

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     0.25

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     0.25

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     0.25

Large Cap Index Fund

     0.10

Marsico Global Fund

     0.80

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

     0.80

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     0.00

Mid Cap Index Fund

     0.10

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

     0.00

Overseas Value Fund

     0.82

Short Term Bond Fund

     0.30

Small Cap Index Fund

     0.10

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
and up to
$1 billion
    In excess
of $1
billion
and up to
$1.5 billion
    In excess
of $1.5
billion
 

Convertible Securities Fund

     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.50

High Income Fund

     0.55     0.52     0.49     0.46

Mid Cap Value Fund

     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.50

 

62


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
 

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     0.30     0.25

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    In excess
of $500
million
and up to
$1 billion
    In excess
of $1
billion
 

Small Cap Growth Fund II

     0.70     0.65     0.60

Small Cap Value Fund II

     0.70     0.65     0.60

For LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, the Adviser is entitled to receive an investment advisory fee of 0.50% on LifeGoal® Income Portfolio’s average daily net assets based on assets that are invested in individual securities, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio and Corporate Bond Portfolio. LifeGoal® Income Portfolio is not charged an advisory fee on its assets that are invested in other Columbia Funds (excluding Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio and Corporate Bond Portfolio. Actual management fees will be charged to the LifeGoal® Income Portfolio based on a weighted average of applicable underlying assets of the Portfolio).

Advisory Fees Paid by the Funds

The Previous Adviser received fees from the Funds for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show the advisory fees paid to and, as applicable, waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,864,932       $ 3,723,034       $ 6,072,972   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Global Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 600,279       $ 1,445,555       $ 3,094,056   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

   $ 187,426         —           —     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,787,603       $ 2,181,829       $ 2,717,957   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 366,741   

Amount Waived

   $ 151,553       $ 431,216         —     

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,231,458       $ 2,246,733       $ 2,721,298   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 1,647,710   

Amount Waived

   $ 1,389,496       $ 1,330,267         —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 11,014,155       $ 13,798,451       $ 19,857,743   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

   $ 66,850         —         $ 216,667   

 

63


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 25,152,257       $ 11,168,797       $ 42,309,565   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —         $ 415,508       $ 114,774   

Marsico Global Fund**

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 37,247       $ 30,317         N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Waived

   $ 178,993         —           N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 10,350,691       $ 19,536,182       $ 26,230,465   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,614,963       $ 1,674,088       $ 2,134,906   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 1,787,724   

Amount Waived

   $ 907,678       $ 1,688,944         —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 20,846,297       $ 22,018,205       $ 22,654,210   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 9,501,068       $ 12,759,354       $ 16,139,511   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 58,138       $ 59,187         N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 133,414       $ 208,317         N/A   

Amount Waived

     —           —        

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,163,978       $ 1,162,242       $ 1,544,845   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

   $ 43,874         —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 8,000,936       $ 7,949,823       $ 5,519,875   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Recovery of Fees Waived or Expenses Reimbursed by the Previous Adviser

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no advisory fees prior to that date.
*** Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no advisory fees prior to that date.

 

64


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,
2009*
    Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29,
2008*
    Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2007*
 

International Value Fund**

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 13,867,175       $ 18,922,007      $ 28,581,565      $ 32,446,266   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —          —          —     

Large Cap Core Fund

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,991,679       $ 6,940,605      $ 22,723 ***    $ 8,858,839   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —          —          —     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 18,946,739       $ 7,416,891      $ 78,891 ***    $ 27,024,538   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —         $ 224,668      $ 29,325        —     

Marsico Growth Fund

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 23,646,080       $ 7,022,977 1    $ 36,479,028 2    $ 30,737,961   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —        $ 88,981        —     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

         

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,294,866       $ 2,821,583      $ 9,170 ***    $ 3,660,996   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —          —          —     

Recovery of Fees Waived by the Previous Adviser

     —           —        $ 103,156        —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.
** Because this Feeder Fund’s advisory fees are paid at the Master Portfolio level, amounts shown are for its Master Portfolio, which may include one or more additional feeder funds.
*** Until February 28, 2008, the Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For the period April 1, 2007 to February 28, 2008, Columbia Large Cap Core Master Portfolio paid $8,302,783 in advisory fees, Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Master Portfolio paid $27,944,659 in advisory fees and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II paid $3,791,375 in advisory fees.
1

Until November 10, 2008, Marsico Growth Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For the period March 1, 2008 to November 10, 2008, Columbia Marsico Growth Master Portfolio paid $25,572,128 in advisory fees, $309,527 of which was waived by the Adviser.

2

Amounts shown are for the Fund’s corresponding Master Portfolio, which may include one or more additional feeder funds.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 555,327       $ 624,721       $ 884,316   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 177,252         —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

65


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2008*
 

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 877,537       $ 895,804       $ 628,029   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 249,629       $ 299,298       $ 245,824   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 531,704       $ 508,291       $ 483,879   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 221,167       $ 212,433       $ 246,888   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

High Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,368,680       $ 1,251,540       $ 351,545 ** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,343,431       $ 1,479,159       $ 2,458,096   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 879,067       $ 1,008,735       $ 1,849,265   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 346,254       $ 362,391       $ 528,855   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 15,573       $ 16,419       $ 18,539   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 147,165       $ 88,426       $ 127,894   

Amount Waived

   $ 3,114       $ 3,284       $ 3,708   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 649,165       $ 637,768       $ 665,252   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 249,129       $ 239,429       $ 267,402   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 409,217       $ 483,770       $ 454,382   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Advisory Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

66


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2010*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2009*
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31,
2008*
 

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 807,714       $ 743,468       $ 716,191   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 259,947       $ 259,156       $ 293,196   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,778,812       $ 3,615,919       $ 2,820,376   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 531,044       $ 221,792       $ 188,025   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,376,376       $ 2,263,618       $ 1,244,272   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 223,599       $ 602,386       $ 470,889   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 810,122       $ 831,600       $ 735,156   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 247,880       $ 267,234       $ 273,304   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 4,695,452       $ 5,302,451       $ 6,392,539   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,332,156       $ 1,321,628       $ 1,314,492   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 298,704       $ 367,033       $ 386,045   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.
** Until February 28, 2008, the Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For the period April 1, 2007 to February 27, 2008, Columbia High Income Master Portfolio paid $6,040,994 in advisory fees, none of which was waived or reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for the Funds are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Alfred F. Alley III, CFA

  

Large Cap Index Fund

Mid Cap Index Fund

Small Cap Index Fund

Leonard A. Aplet, CFA

   Short Term Bond Fund

 

67


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Kent M. Bergene

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Wayne M. Collette, CFA

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Brian M. Condon, CFA

   Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Fred Copper, CFA

  

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund*

Overseas Value Fund

James D’Arcy, CFA

  

California Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

Georgia Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

Maryland Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Virginia Intermediate Municipal
Bond Fund

Lori J. Ensinger, CFA

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Jarl Ginsberg, CFA

   Small Cap Value Fund II

David I. Hoffman

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Yan Jin

   Convertible Securities Fund

David Joy

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

David L. King, CFA

   Convertible Securities Fund

Brian Lavin, CFA

   Total Return Bond Fund

Craig Leopold, CFA

   Large Cap Core Fund

Gregory Scott Liechty

   Short Term Bond Fund

 

68


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Lawrence W. Lin, CFA

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Colin Moore

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund*

George J. Myers, CFA

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Brian D. Neigut

   Small Cap Growth Fund II

Carl W. Pappo, CFA

  

Corporate Bond Portfolio

Total Return Bond Fund

Kent M. Peterson, PhD

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Noah J. Petrucci, CFA

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Alexander D. Powers

   Total Return Bond Fund

Lee Reddin

   Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Peter Santoro, CFA

   Large Cap Core Fund

Marie M. Schofield, CFA

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

LifeGoal® Income

Masters International Equity Portfolio

Diane L. Sobin, CFA

  

Large Cap Value Fund

Mid Cap Value Fund

Christian K. Stadlinger, PhD, CFA

   Small Cap Value Fund II

Ronald B. Stahl, CFA

   Short Term Bond Fund

Michael W. Zazzarino

  

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Total Return Bond Fund

 

* Responsible for the portion of the Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund that is advised by the Adviser.

 

69


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about each Fund’s portfolio manager(s) as of the end of the Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date including the number and amount of assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the portfolio manager(s) managed.

 

         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28                
Convertible Securities Fund    Yan Jin   3 other accounts   $500,000   None   None   (1)
     David L. King, CFA1   18 other accounts   $38.5 million   None   None   (1)
Large Cap Core Fund    Craig Leopold, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

500 other accounts

  $75 million

$275 million

$1 billion

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
     Peter Santoro, CFA   2 RICs

2 PIVs

500 other accounts

  $150 million

$275 million

$1 billion

  None   $50,001-
$100,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund    Brian M. Condon, CFA   2 RICs

8 PIVs

38 other accounts

  $324 million

$837 million

$2.569 billion

  1 other account
($23 million)
  None   (1)
Large Cap Index Fund    Alfred F. Alley III, CFA   3 RICs

4 PIV

19 other accounts

  $3.382 billion

$224.9 million

$3.723 billion

  None   $1-
$10,000
a
  (1)
Large Cap Value Fund    Lori J. Ensinger, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,637 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a
  (1)
   David I. Hoffman   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
b
  (1)
   Noah J. Petrucci, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $50,001 -
$100,000
a

$1-
$10,000
b

  (1)
     Diane L. Sobin, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,648 other accounts

  $4.83 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
Mid Cap Index
Fund
   Alfred F. Alley III, CFA   3 RICs

4 PIV

19 other accounts

  $4.104 billion

$224.9 million

$3.723 billion

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a
  (1)
Mid Cap Value Fund    Lori J. Ensinger, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,637 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $50,001-
$100,000
a
  (1)

 

70


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
   David I. Hoffman   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a
  (1)
   Noah J. Petrucci, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,643 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a
  (1)
     Diane L. Sobin, CFA   11 RICs

2 PIV

4,648 other accounts

  $2.73 billion

$375 million

$2.5 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a

$10,001-
$50,000
b

  (1)
Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund**    Fred Copper, CFA   9 RICs

4 PIV

24 other accounts

  $1.41 billion

$634.7 million

$86.9 million

  None   None   (1)
     Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  $2.12 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 million

  None   None   (1)
Overseas Value Fund    Fred Copper, CFA   9 RICs

4 PIV

24 other accounts

  $2.0 billion

$634.7 million

$86.9 million

  None   None   (1)
Small Cap Growth Fund II    Wayne M. Collette, CFA1   10 RICs

1 PIVs

114 other accounts

  $2.546 billion

$125.4 million

$216.4 million

  None   None   (1)
   Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   7 RICs

1 PIVs

108 other accounts

  $2.129 billion

$125.4 million

$138.8 million

  None   None   (1)
   George J. Myers, CFA1   7 RICs

1 PIVs

103 other accounts

  $2.129 billion

$125.4 million

$138.8 million

  None   None   (1)
     Brian D. Neigut1   7 RICs

1 PIV

105 other accounts

  $2.129 billion

$125.4 million

$138.6 million

  None   None   (1)
Small Cap Index
Fund
   Alfred F. Alley III, CFA   3 RICs

4 PIV

19 other accounts

  $4.656 billion

$224.9 million

$3.723 billion

  None   $1-
$10,000a
  (1)
Small Cap Value Fund II    Jarl Ginsberg, CFA   2 RICs

37 other accounts

  $0.2 billion

$0.4 billion

  None   $100,001-
$500,000
a
  (1)
     Christian K. Stadlinger, PhD, CFA   2 RICs

33 other accounts

  $0.2 billion

$0.4 billion

  None   $500,001-
$1,000,000
a

$50,001-
$100,000
b

  (1)

 

71


Table of Contents

 

         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31                
Asset Allocation Fund II    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $2 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.521 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $2 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $2 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Corporate Bond Portfolio    Carl W. Pappo, CFA   4 RICs

3 other accounts

  $5.626 billion

$850,000

  None   None   (1)
Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.519 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.039 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.519 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $1.519 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.708 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)

 

72


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.228 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.708 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $1.708 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.955 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.475 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.955 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $1.955 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $2.07 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Bergene   6 RICs

8 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.47 million

  None   None   (2)
   David Joy   6 RICs

6 other accounts

  $4.067 billion

$1.12 million

  None   None   (2)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.59 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $2.07 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)

 

73


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIV

16 other accounts

  $2.07 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Masters International Equity Portfolio    Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  $1.963 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 million

  None   None   (1)
   Fred Copper, CFA   10 RICs

4 PIVs

24 other accounts

  $1.8 billion

$634.7 million

$92.4 million

  None   None   (1)
   Colin Moore   18 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $3.483 billion

$2.4 billion

$299 billion

  None   None   (1)
   Kent M. Peterson, PhD   16 RICs

26 PIV

21 other accounts

  $1.963 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Marie M. Schofield, CFA   16 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  $1.963 billion

$2.4 billion

$296 billion

  None   None   (1)
Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio    Lee Reddin   2 other accounts   $120,000   None   None   (1)
     Michael W. Zazzarino   5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  $4.766 billion

$2.64 billion

$1.92 billion

  None   None   (1)
North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Short Term Bond Fund    Leonard A. Aplet, CFA   5 RICs

9 PIVs

80 other accounts

  $410 million

$3.34 billion

$3.65 billion

  None   Over
$1,000,000
a

$1-
$10,000
b

  (1)
   Gregory Scott Liechty   19 other accounts   $59 million   None   None   (1)
     Ronald B. Stahl   7 RICs

9 PIVs

62 other accounts

  $420 million

$3.34 billion

$3.64 billion

  None   None   (1)
Short Term Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   $10,001-
$50,000
a

$1-
$10,000
b

  (1)

 

74


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)        

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned
  Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)
Total Return Bond Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA2   2 RICs

1 PIVs

4 other accounts

  $2.92 billion

$9.56 million

$766.77 million

  None   None   (2)
   Carl W. Pappo, CFA   4 RICs

3 other accounts

  $4.355 billion

$850,000

  None   None   (1)
   Alexander D. Powers   2 RICs

7 PIVs

17 other accounts

  $2.105 billion

$2.1 billion

$1.1 billion

  None   None   (1)
     Michael W. Zazzarino   5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  $3.516 billion

$2.64 billion

$1.92 billion

  None   None   (1)
Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    James D’Arcy, CFA   1 RICs

2 PIVs

12 other accounts

  $2.556 billion

$266.8 million

$189.3 million

  None   None   (1)

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
**

Reflects information for the portion of the Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund that is advised by the Adviser.

a

Excludes any notional investments.

b

Notional investments through a deferred compensation account.

1

Account information provided as of March 31, 2010.

2

Information provided as of April 30, 2010.

Structure of Compensation

(1) Compensation of Legacy Columbia Management Advisors, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of the Previous Adviser prior to May 1, 2010, is typically paid in the form of salary, bonus, stock options, restricted stock and notional investments through an incentive plan, the value of which is measured by reference to the performance of the Columbia Funds in which the account is invested. The bonus for these portfolio managers is variable and generally is based on (1) an evaluation of the portfolio manager’s investment performance and (2) the results of a peer and/or management review of the portfolio manager, which takes into account skills and attributes such as team participation, investment process, communication and professionalism. In evaluating investment performance, the Adviser generally considers the one, three and five year performance of mutual funds and other accounts managed by the portfolio manager relative to the benchmarks and peer groups noted below, emphasizing the portfolio manager’s three and five year performance. The Adviser also may consider a portfolio manager’s performance in managing client assets in sectors and industries assigned to the portfolio manager as part of his/her investment team responsibilities, when applicable. For portfolio managers who also have group management responsibilities, another factor in their evaluation is an assessment of the group’s overall investment performance. The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

 

75


Table of Contents

 

(2) Compensation of Legacy RiverSource Investments, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of RiverSource Investments, LLC (now known as Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC), is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, and (ii) an annual cash bonus, a portion of which may be subject to a mandatory deferral program, and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The Adviser’s portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Adviser employees. Depending upon their job level, Adviser portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Adviser employees at the same job level.

For Mr. Bergene and Mr. Joy, the annual cash bonus is based on management’s assessment of the employee’s performance relative to individual and business unit goals and objectives. The assessment may be based, in part, on achieving certain investment performance goals and retaining and attracting assets under management. For Mr. Joy, the assessment may be based, in part, on achieving certain investment performance goals and retaining and attracting assets under management, and for Mr. Bergene, on developing competitive products, managing existing products, and selecting and monitoring subadvisers for funds. In addition, subject to certain vesting requirements, the compensation of Mr. Joy includes an annual award based on the performance of Ameriprise Financial over rolling three-year periods. This program has been discontinued and the final award under this plan covered the three-year period that started in January 2007 and ended in December 2009.

For all other portfolio managers, the annual cash bonus is paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by the aggregate market competitive bonus targets for the teams of which the portfolio manager is a member and by the short-term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to applicable benchmarks or the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of the Adviser has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

Performance Benchmarks

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Alfred F. Alley III

   Large Cap Index Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper S&P 500 Index Objective Funds Classification
   Mid Cap Index Fund    S&P MidCap 400® Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Small Cap Index Fund    S&P Small Cap 600® Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification

Leonard A. Aplet

   Short Term Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 1-3 Year Government/Credit Index    Lipper Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

 

76


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Anwiti Bahuguna, PhD

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Kent M. Bergene

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification

 

77


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Wayne M. Collette

   Small Cap Growth Fund II   

Russell 2000 Index

Russell 2000 Growth Index

   Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Brian M. Condon

   Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Classification

Fred Copper, CFA

   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    MSCI EAFE Index    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Overseas Value Fund    MSCI EAFE Value Index    Lipper International Large-Cap Value Funds Classification

James D’Arcy

   California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital California 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper California Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Short Term Municipal Bond Fund    BofA Merrill Lynch 1-3 Year U.S. Municipal Index    Lipper Short Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification
   Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 3-15 Year Blend Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Other States Intermediate Municipal Debt Funds Classification

Lori J. Ensinger

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell MidCap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Jarl Ginsberg

   Small Cap Value Fund II    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Classificationa

 

78


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

David I. Hoffman

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell MidCap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Yan Jin

   Convertible Securities Fund    BofA Merrill Lynch
All Convertibles
All Qualities
   Lipper Convertible Securities Classification

David Joy

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification

David L. King

   Convertible Securities Fund    BofA Merrill Lynch
All Convertibles
All Qualities
   Lipper Convertible Securities Classification

Brian Lavin

   Total Return Bond Fund   

Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond

Index

   Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Craig Leopold

   Large Cap Core Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Classification

Gregory Scott Liechty

   Short Term Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 1-3 Year Government/Credit Index    Lipper Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Lawrence W. Lin

   Small Cap Growth Fund II    Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

79


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Colin Moore

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

George J. Myers

   Small Cap Growth Fund II    Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Brian D. Neigut

   Small Cap Growth Fund II    Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Carl W. Pappo

   Corporate Bond Portfolio    Barclays Capital
Credit Bond Index
   N/A
   Total Return Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Kent M. Peterson, PhD

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification

 

80


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Noah J. Petrucci

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell Mid Cap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Alexander D. Powers

   Total Return Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Lee Reddin

   Mortgage and Asset-Backed Portfolio    Barclays Capital U.S. Securitized Index    N/A

Peter Santoro

   Large Cap Core Fund    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Classification

Marie M. Schofield, CFA

   Asset Allocation Fund II    Russell 1000 Index/Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification
   LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio    S&P 500® Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification

 

81


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   LifeGoal® Income Portfolio    Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index; Blended: 80% Barclays Capital Aggregate 1-3 Years Index/20% Barclays Capital Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper General Bond Funds Classification
   Masters International Equity Portfolio    MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper International Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Diane L. Sobin

   Large Cap Value Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large-Cap Value Classification
   Mid Cap Value Fund    Russell Mid Cap Value Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Value Classification

Christian K. Stadlinger

   Small Cap Value Fund II    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Classification

Ronald B. Stahl

   Short Term Bond Fund    Barclays Capital 1-3 Year Government/Credit Index    Lipper Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

Michael W. Zazzarino

   Mortgage and Asset-Backed Portfolio    Barclays Capital U.S. Securitized Index   

Lipper Intermediate Investment

 

Grade Debt Funds Classification

   Total Return Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment
Grade Debt Funds Classification

The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

Like other investment professionals with multiple clients, a Fund’s portfolio manager(s) may face certain potential conflicts of interest in connection with managing both the Fund and other accounts at the same time. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance policies and procedures that attempt to address certain of the potential conflicts that portfolio managers face in this regard. Certain of these conflicts of interest are summarized below.

The management of accounts with different advisory fee rates and/or fee structures, including accounts that pay advisory fees based on account performance (performance fee accounts), may raise potential conflicts of interest for a portfolio manager by creating an incentive to favor higher fee accounts.

Potential conflicts of interest also may arise when a portfolio manager has personal investments in other accounts that may create an incentive to favor those accounts. As a general matter and subject to the Adviser’s Code of Ethics and certain limited exceptions, the Adviser’s investment professionals do not have the opportunity to invest in client accounts, other than the Funds. A portfolio manager who is responsible for managing multiple funds and/or accounts may devote unequal time and attention to the management of those funds and/or accounts. The effects of this potential conflict may be more pronounced where funds and/or accounts managed by a particular portfolio manager have different investment strategies.

 

82


Table of Contents

 

A portfolio manager may be able to select or influence the selection of the broker/dealers that are used to execute securities transactions for the Funds. A portfolio manager’s decision as to the selection of broker/dealers could produce disproportionate costs and benefits among the Funds and the other accounts the portfolio manager manages.

A potential conflict of interest may arise when a portfolio manager buys or sells the same securities for a Fund and other accounts. On occasions when a portfolio manager considers the purchase or sale of a security to be in the best interests of a Fund as well as other accounts, the Adviser’s trading desk may, to the extent consistent with applicable laws and regulations, aggregate the securities to be sold or bought in order to obtain the best execution and lower brokerage commissions, if any. Aggregation of trades may create the potential for unfairness to a Fund or another account if a portfolio manager favors one account over another in allocating the securities bought or sold.

“Cross trades,” in which a portfolio manager sells a particular security held by a Fund to another account (potentially saving transaction costs for both accounts), could involve a potential conflict of interest if, for example, a portfolio manager is permitted to sell a security from one account to another account at a higher price than an independent third party would pay. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance procedures that provide that any transactions between the Fund and another account managed by the Adviser are to be made at a current market price, consistent with applicable laws and regulations.

Another potential conflict of interest may arise based on the different investment objectives and strategies of a Fund and other accounts managed by its portfolio manager(s). Depending on another account’s objectives and other factors, a portfolio manager may give advice to and make decisions for a Fund that may differ from advice given, or the timing or nature of decisions made, with respect to another account. A portfolio manager’s investment decisions are the product of many factors in addition to basic suitability for the particular account involved. Thus, a portfolio manager may buy or sell a particular security for certain accounts, and not for a Fund, even though it could have been bought or sold for the Fund at the same time. A portfolio manager also may buy a particular security for one or more accounts when one or more other accounts are selling the security (including short sales). There may be circumstances when a portfolio manager’s purchases or sales of portfolio securities for one or more accounts may have an adverse effect on other accounts, including the Funds.

A Fund’s portfolio manager(s) also may have other potential conflicts of interest in managing the Fund, and the description above is not a complete description of every conflict that could exist in managing the Fund and other accounts. Many of the potential conflicts of interest to which the Adviser’s portfolio managers are subject are essentially the same or similar to the potential conflicts of interest related to the investment management activities of the Adviser and its affiliates. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

Manager of Managers Exemption

The SEC has issued an order that permits the Adviser, subject to the approval of the Board, to appoint an unaffiliated subadviser or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for a Fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits a Fund to add or to change unaffiliated subadvisers or to change the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change. The Adviser and its affiliates may have other relationships, including significant financial relationships, with current or potential subadvisers or their affiliates, which may create certain conflicts of interest. When making recommendations to the Board to appoint or to change a subadviser, or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement, the Adviser discloses to the Board the nature of any material relationships it has with a subadviser or its affiliates.

 

83


Table of Contents

 

For Global Value Fund and Marsico Growth Fund, if the Funds were to seek to rely on the order, holders of a majority of the fund’s outstanding voting securities would need to approve operating the fund in this manner. There is no assurance shareholder approval, if sought, will be received, and no changes will be made without shareholder approval until that time.

The Subadvisers and Investment Subadvisory Services

Brandes

Brandes is the investment subadviser to Global Value Fund and Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. The International Value Fund is a Feeder Fund and does not have its own subadviser(s) because it invests all of its assets in Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. With respect to the International Value Fund, Brandes earns its fee as the investment subadviser to the Columbia International Value Master Portfolio. See the Management of the Fund – Primary Services Providers section in the International Value Fund’s prospectus.

Brandes is 100% beneficially owned by senior professionals of the firm. The principal offices of Brandes are located at 11988 El Camino Real, Suite 500, San Diego, California 92130. As of March 31, 2010, Brandes had approximately $51.6 billion in assets under management.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, Brandes selects and manages the respective investments of each Fund for which it serves as investment subadviser. Brandes performs its duties subject at all times to the control of the Board and in conformity with the stated policies of each Fund.

Its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement generally provides that in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of Brandes’ obligations or duties thereunder, or any of its respective officers, directors, employees or agents, Brandes shall not be subject to liability to the Trust or to any shareholder of the Trust for any act or omission in the course of rendering services thereunder or for any losses that may be sustained in the purchase, holding or sale of any security.

The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement became effective with respect to a Fund after approval by the Board, and after an initial two year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Trust’s Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to a Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Adviser on 60 days’ written notice.

The Adviser, from the investment advisory fees it receives, pays Brandes for the services it provides to a Fund based on the percentage of the average daily net assets of that Fund, as set forth in the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor or to selling or servicing agents for services they provide.

 

84


Table of Contents

 

Subadvisory Rates Paid to Brandes

The Adviser pays Brandes, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Global Value Fund and Columbia International Value Master Portfolio, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the average daily net assets:

 

Fund/Master Portfolio

  

Rate of Compensation

Global Value Fund

  

•   0.50% on aggregate assets of Global Value Fund on the first $1 billion

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of Global Value Fund above $1 billion

Columbia International Value Master Portfolio

  

•   0.50% of average daily net assets of International Value Master Portfolio

Subadvisory Fees Paid to Brandes

Brandes received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for its services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the subadvisory fees paid to Brandes, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Global Value Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 324,922       $ 799,901       $ 1,715,858   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29, 2008
     Fiscal Year
Ended
March 31, 2007
 

International Value Fund*

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 8,841,168       $ 12,462,818       $ 19,593,220       $ 22,308,152   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* Because this Feeder Fund’s advisory fees are paid at the Master Portfolio level, amounts shown are for its Master Portfolio.

Brandes Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the Brandes portfolio manager(s) responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds identified below. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Brandes portfolio manager(s) responsible for the Fund(s) are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Jim Brown, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Glenn R. Carlson, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Brent Fredberg

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

 

85


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Jeffrey Germain, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Amelia M. Morris, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Brent V. Woods, CFA

  

Global Value Fund

International Value Fund

Brandes Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about the number and assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the Brandes portfolio manager(s) managed, as of the end of each Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date.

 

        Other Accounts Managed by the Brandes Portfolio Managers
(excluding the Fund)
   
Fund   Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned

For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28

Global Value Fund   Jim Brown, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
 

Glenn R. Carlson, CFA1

  8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Brent Fredberg1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Jeffrey Germain, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Amelia M. Morris, CFA1   8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
   

Brent V. Woods, CFA1

  8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None

International Value Fund

  Jim Brown, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None

 

86


Table of Contents
        Other Accounts Managed by the Brandes Portfolio Managers
(excluding the Fund)
   
Fund   Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
  Approximate
Total Net
Assets
  Performance
Based Accounts
  Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned
  Glenn R. Carlson, CFA1   8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Brent Fredberg1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Jeffrey Germain, CFA1   6 RICs

28 PIVs

4,135 other
accounts

  $3.968 billion

$6.927 billion

$37.564 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
  Amelia M. Morris, CFA1   8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None
   

Brent V. Woods, CFA1

  8 RICs

51 PIVs

4,813 other
accounts

  $4.014 billion

$7.983 billion

$39.577 billion

  13 other accounts
($4.177 billion)
  None

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
1

Account information provided as of March 31, 2010.

Brandes Portfolio Manager(s) Compensation

Brandes’ compensation structure for portfolio managers/analysts is four-fold: competitive base salaries, participation in an annual bonus plan, participation in profit sharing plan and eligibility for participation in the firm’s equity through partnership or phantom equity. Compensation is fixed. Participation in the annual bonus plan is linked to a number of qualitative and quantitative evaluation criteria. The criteria include research productivity, performance of portfolio management professionals, and the attainment of client service goals. Compensation is not based on the performance of the Fund or other accounts.

Brandes Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

For a small number of accounts, Brandes may be compensated based on the profitability of the account, such as by a performance-based management fee. These incentive compensation structures may create a conflict of interest for Brandes with regard to other accounts where the Adviser is paid based on a percentage of assets in that the portfolio manager may have an incentive to allocate securities preferentially to the accounts where Brandes might share in investment gains. In order to address these potential conflicts, Brandes’ investment decision-making and trade allocation policies and procedures are designed to ensure that none of Brandes’ clients are disadvantaged in Brandes’ management of accounts. Additionally, Brandes’ internal controls are tested on a routine schedule as part of the firm’s Compliance Monitoring Program.

It is possible that at times identical securities will be held by more than one fund and/or account. If the Large Cap Investment Committee identifies a limited investment opportunity that may be suitable for more than

 

87


Table of Contents

one Fund or other account, a Fund may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of filled purchase or sale orders across all eligible Funds and other accounts. To deal with these situations, Brandes has adopted procedures for allocating portfolio transactions across multiple accounts. For client accounts, including the Fund, that are able to participate in aggregated transactions, Brandes utilizes a rotational trading system to execute client transactions in order to provide, over the long-run, fair treatment for each client account.

Members of the Large Cap Investment Committee may invest in a fund or other account that they are involved in the management of and a conflict may arise where they may therefore have an incentive to treat the fund that they invest in preferentially as compared to other accounts. In order to address this potential conflict, Brandes’ investment decision-making and trade allocation policies and procedures are designed to ensure that none of Brandes’ clients are disadvantaged in Brandes’ management of accounts.

Causeway

Causeway served as co-investment subadviser to approximately half of the assets of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund until July 8, 2009. At that time, the Previous Adviser assumed primary investment management responsibility for that portion of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund previously sub-advised by Causeway.

Subadvisory Rates Paid to Causeway

Until July 8, 2009, at which time the Adviser assumed primary investment management responsibility for that portion of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund previously sub-advised by Causeway, the Previous Adviser paid Causeway, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rate listed below as a percentage of the average daily net assets of the Fund:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

  

•   0.43% of aggregate average daily net assets of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Subadvisory Fees Paid to Causeway

Causeway received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for its services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the subadvisory fees paid to Causeway, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal years.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2008
 

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,379,059       $ 4,183,414       $ 5,502,776   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

MacKay Shields

MacKay Shields is the investment subadviser to High Income Fund. MacKay Shields’ principal office is located at 9 West 57th Street, New York, NY 10019.

 

88


Table of Contents

 

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, MacKay Shields selects and manages the respective investments of High Income Fund for which it serves as investment subadviser. MacKay Shields performs its duties subject at all times to the control of the Board and in conformity with the stated policies of the Fund. Its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement generally provides that in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of MacKay Shields’ obligations or duties thereunder, or any of its respective officers, directors, employees or agents, MacKay Shields shall not be subject to liability to the Trust or to any shareholder of the Trust for any act or omission in the course of rendering services thereunder or for any losses that may be sustained in the purchase, holding or sale of any security.

The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement became effective with respect to a Fund after approval by the Board, and after an initial two year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Trust’s Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to a Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Adviser on 60 days’ written notice.

The Adviser, from the investment advisory fees it receives, pays MacKay Shields for the services it provides to a Fund based on the percentage of the average daily net assets of that Fund, as set forth in the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor or to selling or servicing agents for services they provide.

Subadvisory Rates Paid to MacKay Shields

The Adviser pays MacKay Shields full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Columbia High Income Fund, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the average daily net assets of the Fund:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

High Income Fund

  

•   0.40% of the average daily net assets of High Income Fund up to and including $100 million

•   0.375% of average daily net assets of High Income Fund in excess of $100 million and up to and including $200 million

•   0.35% of average daily net assets of High Income Fund in excess of $200 million

Subadvisory Fees Paid to MacKay Shields

MacKay Shields received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for its services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the subadvisory fees paid to MacKay Shields, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal periods.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

High Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,737,848       $ 2,508,574       $ 3,219,688   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

*

Until February 28, 2008, the Fund operated as a “Feeder Fund” and invested all or substantially all of its assets in a corresponding Master Portfolio that was a series of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC. For

 

89


Table of Contents
 

the period April 1, 2007 to February 28, 2008, Columbia High Income Master Portfolio paid $2,985,314 in advisory fees, and from February 28, 2008 through March 31, 2008, the Fund paid $234,374 in subadvisory fees.

MacKay Shields Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the MacKay Shields portfolio manager responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Fund identified below. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of the Fund’s prospectus, the MacKay Shields portfolio manager responsible for the Fund is:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

J. Matthew Philo, CFA

   High Income Fund

MacKay Shields Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about the number and assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the MacKay Shields portfolio manager(s) managed, as of the end of the Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date.

 

         

Other Accounts Managed by the MacKay Shields
Portfolio Managers (excluding the Fund)

      
Fund    Portfolio Manager    Number and Type
of Account*
   Approximate
Total Net Assets
   Performance
Based Accounts
   Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially Owned
 

For the Fund with fiscal year ending March 31

     

High Income Fund

   J. Matthew Philo,
CFA
  

4 RICs

2 PIVs

46 other accounts

  

$7.907 billion

$450 million

$10.6 billion

   2 PIVs ($12.7 million)      None   

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.

MacKay Shields Portfolio Manager(s) Compensation

MacKay Shields establishes salaries at competitive levels, verified through industry surveys, to attract and maintain the best professional talent. In addition, an incentive bonus equal to a significant percentage of the firm’s pre-tax profits is paid annually to the firm’s employees based upon an individual’s performance and the profitability of the firm. The bonus generally represents a sizable amount relative to the base salary, and when considered with the base salary, results in a highly attractive level of total cash compensation for the firm’s professional employees. Every MacKay Shields employee participates in the bonus pool. This approach instills a strong sense of commitment on the part of each employee towards the overall success of the firm. There is no difference between the method used in determining portfolio manager’s compensation with respect to the High Income Fund and other accounts.

MacKay Shields has performance-based fee arrangements with “eligible clients”, as that term is defined under Rule 205-3 of the 1940 Act, who have requested such arrangements. Performance-based fees may be calculated as a percentage of returns, or as a percentage of the increase in net asset value, and may be tied to a client-directed benchmark or loss carry forward. A portion of these performance-based fees forms a part of the bonus pool for all MacKay Shields employees. Of course, there are periods in which MacKay Shields does not earn any performance fee. Such arrangements may appear to create an incentive to make riskier, more speculative investments than would be the case under a solely asset-based fee arrangement.

 

90


Table of Contents

 

MacKay Shields offers a Phantom Stock Plan, which enhances the firm’s ability to attract, retain, motivate, and reward key executives. Awards can be made annually and vesting takes place over a period of several subsequent years. Participation in the current plan by senior professionals is contingent upon the execution of an Executive Employment Agreement.

MacKay Shields Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

MacKay Shields’ High Yield group provides portfolio services for other MacKay Shields accounts, which include: mutual funds; institutional managed accounts; collective trusts and private commingled funds. As previously reported, MacKay Shields’ High Yield group has a domestic hedge fund and an offshore hedge fund, both of which are closed to new investors and whose assets were substantially liquidated during 2009. Except for distinctions based on investment objectives, investment guidelines and cash flow, all accounts are treated the same, regardless of fee structure.

MacKay Shields has performance-based fee arrangements with “eligible clients” (as that term is defined under Rule 205-3 of the 1940 Act) who have requested such arrangements. Performance-based fees may be calculated as a percentage of returns, or as a percentage of the increase in net asset value, and may be tied to a client-directed benchmark or loss carry forward. A portion of these performance-based fees forms a part of the bonus pool for all MacKay Shields employees. Of course, there are periods in which MacKay Shields does not earn any performance fee. Such arrangements may appear to create an incentive to make riskier, more speculative investments than would be the case under a solely asset-based fee arrangement. As previously reported, the two hedge funds with performance fees managed by the same product area that manages the High Income Fund are in the process of being liquidated.

To address potential conflicts of interest, MacKay Shields has adopted various policies and procedures to provide for equitable treatment of trading activity and to ensure that investment opportunities are allocated in a fair and appropriate manner. In addition, MacKay Shields has adopted a Code of Ethics and other policies and procedures that recognize a manager’s obligation to treat all of its clients, including the High Income Fund, fairly and equitably. These policies, procedures, and the Code of Ethics are designed to restrict a portfolio manager from favoring one client over another.

It is the policy of MacKay Shields not to favor any one client over another. Consistent with this policy,

MacKay Shields has the following procedures, among others: (1) trade allocation procedures that provide for the

pro rata allocation of investment opportunities among clients in a particular strategy, with certain exceptions; (2) a general prohibition against same day opposite direction transactions; and (3) short sale trade procedures requiring pre-approval of short sales and restricting certain short sales.

The Trade Allocation Policy provides that: (i) no client will be favored over any other client; (ii) trades should be pre-allocated, subject to certain exceptions, and allocations should be in writing; and (iii) MacKay Shields’ Legal/Compliance Department conducts periodic reviews of client account performance as a function of allocation to assure that no account or group of accounts is being preferred systematically in the allocation process. The Trade Allocation Policy contains a procedure for limited offerings, which provides that in a limited offering, the allocations may be pro-rata based on size of the order or account size and within a Strategy pro-rata based on account size. Under this policy, when determining which accounts will participate in a trade, the portfolio managers will consider various objective criteria which may include but are not limited to: client cash limitations, actual and anticipated account inflows and outflows, duration and/or average maturity, account size, deal size, trade lots, existing exposure to an issuer or industry type and specific investment objectives and other practical limitations. In general, if the aggregated order is filled in its entirety, it will be allocated among clients in accordance with the target allocation; if the order is partially filled, it will be allocated pro rata based on the allocation methodology recorded in the trade order management system.

 

91


Table of Contents

 

The Cross Trading Policy provides that all cross trades must be pre-cleared by the MacKay Shields Legal/ Compliance Department and require, among other things, that the transaction (a) be a purchase or sale for no consideration other than cash payments against prompt delivery of the security, (b) is effected at the independent market price of the security determined in accordance with applicable methodology; and (c) be effected with no brokerage transaction.

The Valuation Procedures provide, among other requirements, that any fair valuation of a security recommended by a portfolio manager be approved by portfolio managers from two other distinct portfolio management areas. In addition, on a monthly basis a Fair Valuation Committee meeting convenes to review all securities that are being fair valued.

The Proxy-Voting Policies and Procedures are designed to ensure that where clients have delegated proxy voting authority to MacKay Shields, all proxies are voted in the best interest of such clients without regard to the interests of MacKay Shields or related parties. When a client retains MacKay Shields, the firm generally determines through its investment management agreement whether it is authorized to vote proxies on behalf of that client. Currently, MacKay Shields uses Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS), a business unit of RiskMetrics Group, as its third-party proxy voting service provider. If the client appoints MacKay Shields as its proxy-voting agent, the client will also be asked to specify whether its proxies should be voted in accordance with Custom Guidelines provided by the client or in accordance with MacKay Shields’ Standard Guidelines for non-union clients or union clients, as the case may be. These Standard Guidelines follow ISS proxy voting recommendations. MacKay Shields informs the client’s custodian to send all proxies to ISS, and informs ISS that the client has appointed MacKay Shields as its agent and instructs ISS as to which guidelines to follow.

Marsico

Marsico is located at 1200 17th Street, Suite 1600, Denver, CO 80202. Marsico was organized in September 1997 as a registered investment adviser, became a wholly owned indirect subsidiary of Bank of America in January 2001 and was an affiliate of the Previous Adviser until December 2007. Marsico is an independently owned investment management firm. Marsico provides investment management services to other mutual funds and private accounts and, as of March 31, 2010, Marsico had approximately $55 billion in assets under management.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, Marsico selects and manages the respective investments of the Funds for which it serves as investment subadviser. Marsico performs its duties subject at all times to the control of the Board and in conformity with the stated policies of each Fund.

Its Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement generally provides that in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence or reckless disregard of Marsico’s obligations or duties thereunder, or any of its respective officers, directors, employees or agents, Marsico shall not be subject to liability to the Trust or to any shareholder of the Trust for any act or omission in the course of rendering services thereunder or for any losses that may be sustained in the purchase, holding or sale of any security.

The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement became effective with respect to a Fund after approval by the Board, and after an initial two year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Trust’s Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to a Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Adviser on 60 days’ written notice.

 

92


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser, from the investment advisory fees it receives, pays Marsico for the services it provides to a Fund based on the percentage of the average daily net assets of that Fund, as set forth in the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor or to selling or servicing agents for services they provide.

Subadvisory Rates Paid to Marsico

Effective May 1, 2010, the Adviser pays Marsico, and for the period May 1, 2010 through January 1, 2008, the Previous Adviser paid Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico 21st Century Fund, Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund and Marsico Growth Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the aggregate average daily net assets of Columbia U.S. equity funds or portions thereof subadvised by Marsico (“U.S. Funds”)*:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

U.S. Funds

  

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of the U.S. Funds up to $18 billion

•   0.40% on aggregate assets of the U.S. Funds between $18 billion and $21 billion

•   0.35% on aggregate assets of the U.S. Funds above $21 billion

 

*

For purposes of this fee calculation, the assets subadvised by Marsico in the following Columbia Funds will be aggregated: (i) Marsico 21st Century Fund; (ii) Marsico Focused Equities Fund; (iii) Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund, Variable Series; (iv) Columbia Marsico Growth Fund, Variable Series; (v) Columbia Marsico Focused Equities, Variable Series; (vi) Marsico Growth Fund; and (vii) any future Columbia U.S. equity fund subadvised by Marsico, as the Adviser and Marsico mutually agree in writing.

Effective May 1, 2010, the Adviser pays Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico Global Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund and Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the aggregate average daily net assets of Columbia international equity funds or portions thereof subadvised by Marsico (“International Funds”)*:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

International Funds

  

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of the International Funds up to $6 billion

•   0.40% on aggregate assets of the International Funds between $6 billion and $10 billion

•   0.35% on aggregate assets of the International Funds above $10 billion

 

* For purposes of this fee calculation, the assets subadvised by Marsico in the following Columbia Funds will be aggregated: (i) Marsico Global Fund; (ii) Marsico International Opportunities Fund; (iii) Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund; (iv) Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Variable Series; and (v) any future Columbia international equity fund subadvised by Marsico, as the Adviser and Marsico mutually agree in writing.

 

93


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser pays Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico Global Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates listed below as a percentage of the aggregate average daily net assets of the Marsico Global Fund:

 

Fund

  

Rate of Compensation

Marsico Global Fund

  

•   0.45% on aggregate assets of the Marsico Global Fund up to $1.5 billion

•   0.40% on aggregate assets of the Marsico Global Fund between $1.5 billion and $3 billion

•   0.35% on aggregate assets of the Marsico Global Fund above $3 billion

For the period May 1, 2010 through January 1, 2008, the Previous Adviser paid Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed pursuant to the Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement, a subadvisory fee for Marsico Global Fund and Marsico International Opportunities Fund, computed daily and payable monthly, at the annual rates of 0.80% of the aggregate average daily net assets of U.S. Funds.

Immediately prior to January 1, 2008, the Previous Adviser paid Marsico, as full compensation for services provided and expenses assumed, a subadvisory fee for Marsico 21st Century Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Marsico Growth Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund and Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund, computed daily and payable monthly at the annual rate of 0.45% of the average net assets of the respective Fund.

Subadvisory Fees Paid to Marsico

Marsico received subadvisory fees from the Previous Adviser for Marsico’s services as reflected in the following chart, which shows the advisory fees paid to Marsico, the advisory fees waived and expense reimbursements where applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal periods.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2010
    Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2009
    Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Marsico 21st Century Fund

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 17,890,538      $ 30,553,834      $ 8,068,502   

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —          —          —     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 13,085,046      $ 17,405,934      $ 4,579,577 ** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —          —          —     

Marsico Global Fund***

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 20,688      $ 17,043        N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          N/A   

Amount Waived

     —          —          N/A   

Marsico Growth Fund

      

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 16,721,820      $ 23,371,676 **    $ 6,299,921   

Amount Reimbursed

     —          —          —     

Amount Waived

     —          —          —     

 

94


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2010
     Fiscal Year
Ended
February 28,

2009
     Fiscal Period
Ended
February 29,
2008*
 

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,728,038       $ 10,955,978       $ 2,927,361   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,532,116       $ 4,836,093       $ 1,316,794   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* Marsico was an affiliated investment subadviser of the Previous Adviser until December 14, 2007. Therefore, the subadvisory fees paid are for the period December 14, 2007 through February 29, 2008.
** Includes amount paid for services provided to former Master Portfolio.
*** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no subadvisory fees prior to that date.

Marsico Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the Marsico portfolio manager(s) responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds identified below. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Marsico portfolio manager(s) responsible for the Fund(s) are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

James G. Gendelman

   Marsico Global Fund
   Marsico International Opportunities Fund
   Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Corydon J. Gilchrist, CFA

   Marsico 21st Century Fund
   Marsico Global Fund

Thomas F. Marsico

   Marsico Focused Equities Fund
   Marsico Global Fund
   Marsico Growth Fund

A. Douglas Rao

   Marsico Focused Equities Fund
   Marsico Growth Fund

Marsico Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about the number and assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the Marsico portfolio manager(s) managed, as of the end of each Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date.

 

         Other Accounts Managed by the Marsico Portfolio
Managers  (excluding the Fund)
        
Fund    Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
   Approximate
Total Net
Assets
   Performance
Based Accounts
     Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28

  

Marsico 21st Century Fund    Corydon
J.
Gilchrist,
CFA
a
  5 RICs

9 PIVs

10 other accounts

   $4.927 billion

$1.577 billion

$1.6 billion

     None         None   

 

95


Table of Contents
         Other Accounts Managed by the Marsico Portfolio
Managers  (excluding the Fund)
        
Fund    Portfolio Manager   Number and Type
of Account*
   Approximate
Total Net
Assets
   Performance
Based Accounts
     Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in the Fund
Beneficially  Owned
 
Marsico Focused Equities Fund    Thomas F.
Marsico
b
  30 RICs

15 PIVs

136
other
accounts

   $16.402 billion

$2.286 billion

$13.613 billion

     None         None   
     A. Douglas
Rao
c
  10 RICs

2 other
accounts

   $10.335 billion

$4.757 billion

     None         None   
Marsico Global Fund    James G.
Gendelman
  20 RICs

8 PIVs

22 other
accounts

   $8.801 billion

$1.238 billion

$2.201 billion

     None         None   
   Corydon J.
Gilchrist,
CFA
a
  5 RICs

9 PIVs

10 other
accounts

   $4.927 billion

$1.577 billion

$1.6 billion

     None         None   
     Thomas F.
Marsico
b
  30 RICs

15 PIVs

136
other
accounts

   $19.352 billion

$2.286 billion

$13.613 billion

     None         None   
Marsico Growth Fund    Thomas F.
Marsico
b
  30 RICs

15 PIVs

136
other
accounts

   $15.647 billion

$2.286 billion

$13.613 billion

     None         None   
     A. Douglas
Rao
c
  10 RICs

2 other
accounts

   $9.580 billion

$4.757 billion

     None         None   
Marsico International Opportunities Fund    James G.
Gendelman
  20 RICs

8 PIVs

22 other
accounts

   $7.607 billion

$1.238 billion

$2.201 billion

     None         None   
Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund    James G.
Gendelman
  20 RICs

8 PIVs

22 other
accounts

   $8.062 billion

$1.238 billion

$2.201 billion

     None         None   

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
a

One of the “Other Accounts” is a wrap fee platform, which includes 2,357 of underlying clients with total assets of approximately $458 million and one of the “Other Accounts” represents a model portfolio with total assets of approximately $117 million.

b

One of the “Other Accounts” is a wrap fee platform, which includes 9,270 underlying clients with total assets of approximately $2,945 and two of the “Other Accounts” represent model portfolio with total assets of approximately $1.813 billion.

 

96


Table of Contents
c

The “Other Accounts” are a wrap fee platform, which includes approximately 9,270 underlying clients with total assets of approximately $2.945 billion, and a model portfolio with total assets of approximately $1.812 billion.

Marsico Portfolio Manager(s) Compensation

The compensation package for portfolio managers of Marsico is structured as a combination of base salary (may be reevaluated at least annually), and periodic cash bonuses. Bonuses are typically based on a number of factors including Marsico’s overall profitability for the period. Portfolio manager compensation takes into account, among other factors, the overall performance of all accounts for which the portfolio manager provides investment advisory services. In receiving compensation such as bonuses, portfolio managers do not receive special consideration based on the performance of particular accounts, and do not receive compensation from accounts charging performance-based fees. Exceptional individual efforts are rewarded through salary readjustments and greater participation in the bonus pool. No other special employee incentive arrangements are currently in place or being planned. In addition to salary and bonus, portfolio managers may participate in other Marsico benefits to the same extent and on the same basis as other Marsico employees. Portfolio manager compensation comes solely from Marsico. In addition, Marsico’s portfolio managers typically are offered equity interests in Marsico Management Equity, LLC, which indirectly owns Marsico, and may receive distributions on those equity interests.

As a general matter, Marsico does not tie portfolio manager compensation to specific levels of performance relative to fixed benchmarks. Although performance may be a relevant consideration, comparisons with fixed benchmarks may not always be useful. Relevant benchmarks vary depending on specific investment styles and client guidelines or restrictions, and comparisons to benchmark performance may at times reveal more about market sentiment than about a portfolio manager’s abilities. To encourage a long-term horizon for managing portfolios, Marsico evaluates a portfolio manager’s performance over periods longer than the immediate compensation period, and may consider a variety of measures such as the performance of unaffiliated portfolios with similar strategies and other measurements. Other factors that may also be significant in determining portfolio manager compensation include, without limitation, the effectiveness of the manager’s leadership within Marsico’s investment team, contributions to Marsico’s overall performance, discrete securities analysis, idea generation, ability to support and train other analysts, and other considerations.

Marsico Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

As a general matter, Marsico faces the same need to balance the interests of different clients that any investment adviser with multiple clients might experience. Portfolio managers make investment decisions for each portfolio based on the investment objectives, policies, practices and other relevant investment considerations that the managers believe are applicable to that portfolio. Consequently, portfolio managers may or may not purchase (or sell) securities for one portfolio and not another portfolio, or may take similar actions for different portfolios at different times. As a result, the mix of securities purchased in one portfolio may perform better than the mix of securities purchased for another portfolio. Similarly, the sale of securities from one portfolio may cause that portfolio to perform better than others if the value of those securities subsequently decline. The management of multiple accounts may result in a portfolio manager devoting unequal time and attention to the management of each account. Although Marsico does not track the time a portfolio manager spends on a single portfolio, it does assess whether a portfolio manager has adequate time and resources to effectively manage all of the accounts for which he is responsible. Marsico seeks to manage competing interests for the time and attention of portfolio managers.

The need to balance the interests of multiple clients may also arise when allocating and/or aggregating trades. Marsico often aggregates into a single trade order several individual contemporaneous client trade orders in a single security. Under Marsico’s Portfolio Management and Trade Management Policy and Procedures, when trades are aggregated on behalf of more than one account, Marsico seeks to allocate such trades to

 

97


Table of Contents

participating client accounts in a fair and equitable manner. With respect to IPOs and other syndicated or limited offerings, it is Marsico’s policy to seek to ensure that over the long term, accounts with the same or similar investment objectives or strategies will receive an equitable opportunity to participate meaningfully and will not be unfairly disadvantaged. To deal with these situations, Marsico has adopted policies and procedures for allocating transactions across multiple accounts. Marsico’s policies also seek to ensure that portfolio managers do not systematically allocate other types of trades in a manner that would be more beneficial to one account than another. Marsico’s compliance department monitors transactions made on behalf of multiple clients to seek to ensure adherence to its policies.

Marsico has adopted and implemented policies and procedures that seek to minimize potential conflicts of interest that may arise as a result of a portfolio manager advising multiple accounts. In addition, Marsico monitors a variety of areas, including compliance with primary Fund guidelines, the allocation of securities, and compliance with its Code of Ethics.

The Administrator

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (which is also the Adviser) serves as Administrator of the Funds.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator has agreed to provide all of the services and facilities necessary for, or appropriate to, the business and effective operation of each Fund that are not (a) provided by employees or other agents engaged by each Fund or (b) required to be provided by any person pursuant to any other agreement or arrangement with each Fund.

Administration Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

The Administrator receives fees as compensation for its services, which are computed daily and paid monthly, as set forth in the Administrative Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Primary Service Providers – The Administrator in each Fund’s prospectuses.

The Previous Administrator received fees from the Funds for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show administration fees paid to and, as applicable waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 645,345       $ 867,215       $ 1,501,974   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Global Value Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 65,422       $ 211,052       $ 483,369   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 760,800       $ 970,695       $ 1,247,255   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

98


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,231,508       $ 2,238,144       $ 2,721,298   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 3,641,178       $ 4,741,946       $ 7,040,233   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 200,002       $ 200,001   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 8,603,983       $ 15,005,283       $ 15,184,769   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Marsico Global Fund***

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,706,440       $ 5,232,450       $ 7,047,989   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,474,963       $ 1,534,088       $ 1,983,318   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 6,437,740       $ 6,836,190       $ 7,040,843   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,340,535       $ 3,345,352       $ 4,370,355   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Waived

     —           —           N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,163,978       $ 1,162,133       $ 1,544,239   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,916,545       $ 1,901,446       $ 1,229,303   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

99


Table of Contents
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no administration fees prior to that date.
***

Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no administration fees prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
    Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

International Value Fund**

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,523,528       $ 3,627,490       $ 5,790,419      $ 6,574,153   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Large Cap Core Fund

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,646,222       $ 1,967,356       $ 1,820,111 ***    $ 1,907,360 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Marsico Focused Equities

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 6,259,486       $ 8,469,821       $ 5,370,916 ***    $ 5,095,728 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Marsico Growth Fund

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 8,032,650       $ 7,436,572       $ 7,074,752 ***    $ 5,791,064 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

          

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 296,532       $ 372,770       $ 331,182 ***    $ 416,914 *** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —          —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —          —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.
** The Administration fees are paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder Fund –levels; amounts shown above include only the portion paid at the Feeder Fund-level.
*** Prior to the Fund’s conversion from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund, the Administration fees were paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder-Fund levels; amounts shown include only the portion paid at the Feeder-Fund level.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 56,172       $ 68,070       $ 103,492   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 258,160       $ 264,344       $ 163,661   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

100


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 141,447       $ 133,545       $ 115,028   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

High Income Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,610,648       $ 1,462,420       $ 1,581,588 ** 

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 39,883       $ 38,550       $ 39,819   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 27,743       $ 26,949       $ 30,446   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 181,093       $ 177,259       $ 176,246   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 234,514       $ 212,808       $ 193,432   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,556,779       $ 1,550,851       $ 1,165,896   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 97,492       $ 241,564         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

101


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,935,466       $ 1,071,138       $ 511,659   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 235,422       $ 242,696       $ 199,829   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,803,180       $ 2,099,443       $ 2,638,964   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 411,604       $ 408,177       $ 395,351   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.
** Prior to the Fund’s conversion from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund, the Administration fees were paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder-Fund levels; amounts shown include only the portion paid at the Feeder Fund-level.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

State Street is responsible for providing certain pricing and bookkeeping services to the Funds. The Administrator is responsible for overseeing the performance of these services and for certain other services.

Services Provided

Effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into a Financial Reporting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (the Financial Reporting Services Agreement) pursuant to which State Street provides financial reporting services to the Funds. Also effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into an Accounting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (collectively with the Financial Reporting Services Agreement, the State Street Agreements) pursuant to which State Street provides accounting services to the Funds. Effective May 1, 2010, the State Street Agreements were amended to, among other things, assign and delegate the Previous Adviser’s rights and obligations under the State Street Agreements to the Administrator. Under the State Street Agreements, each Fund (except the Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Portfolios and Masters International Equity Portfolio) pays State Street an annual fee of $38,000 paid monthly plus an additional monthly fee based on an annualized percentage rate of average daily net assets of the Fund for the month. The aggregate fee for a Fund during any year shall not exceed $140,000 annually (exclusive of out-of-pocket expenses and charges). Each Fund (except the Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio and LifeGoal® Portfolios), also reimburses State Street for certain out-of-pocket expenses and charges.

Under the State Street Agreements, LifeGoal® Income Portfolio and Masters International Equity Portfolio pay State Street an annual fee of $26,000 paid monthly. LifeGoal® Income Portfolio also reimburses State Street for certain out-of-pocket expenses and charges. Except for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, the LifeGoal® Portfolios do not pay any separate fees for services rendered under the State Street Agreements, and, except for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio, the fees for pricing and bookkeeping services incurred by the LifeGoal® Portfolios are paid as part of the management fee.

 

102


Table of Contents

 

Pursuant to an assumption agreement with the Adviser, Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio do not pay separate fees for services rendered under the State Street Agreements and do not pay fees for pricing and bookkeeping services.

From December 15, 2006 through May 1, 2010, the Trust was party to a Pricing and Bookkeeping Oversight and Services Agreement (the Services Agreement) with the Previous Adviser. Under the Services Agreement, the Previous Adviser provided services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and provided oversight of the accounting and financial reporting services provided by State Street. Under the Services Agreement, each Fund reimbursed the Previous Adviser for out-of-pocket expenses and charges, including fees payable to third parties, such as for pricing the Funds’ portfolio securities, incurred by the Previous Adviser in the performance of services under the Services Agreement. Prior to January 1, 2008, the Funds also reimbursed the Previous Adviser for accounting oversight services and services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Effective May 1, 2010, the services previously provided by the Previous Adviser under the Services Agreement began to be provided by the Administrator under the Administrative Services Agreement, and the Services Agreement was terminated.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Fees Paid by the Funds

The Previous Adviser and State Street received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show the net pricing and bookkeeping fees paid to State Street and to the Previous Adviser for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 117,450       $ 136,127       $ 155,666   

Global Value Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 59,373       $ 72,500       $ 101,627   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 117,947       $ 129,888       $ 142,326   

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,357       $ 141,105       $ 141,180   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 147,990       $ 144,160       $ 151,351   

Marsico Global Fund**

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 22,418       $ 16,411         N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 151,423       $ 150,412       $ 151,942   

 

103


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 145,331       $ 145,519       $ 145,051   

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,991       $ 141,486       $ 141,577   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 155,605       $ 153,963       $ 155,814   

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 15,682       $ 14,124         N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 11,588   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,971       $ 141,609       $ 139,589   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no pricing and bookkeeping fees prior to that date.
*** Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no pricing and bookkeeping fees prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

International Value Fund**

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 38,000       $ 38,000       $ 34,835       $ 38,000   

Large Cap Core Fund

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 144,815       $ 144,115       $ 34,834       $ 38,000   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 143,765       $ 143,367       $ 34,834       $ 38,000   

Marsico Growth Fund***

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 143,813       $ 60,038       $ 38,309       $ 38,000   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603         —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 89,209       $ 100,308       $ 34,834       $ 38,000   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.
** The Pricing and Bookkeeping Fees are paid at both the Master Portfolio- and Feeder Fund-levels; amounts shown above include only the portion paid at the Feeder Fund-level.
*** Marsico Growth Fund converted from a feeder fund in a master/feeder structure to a stand-alone fund on November 10, 2008. All amounts shown prior to that date are only the portion that was paid at the Feeder Fund-level.

 

104


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 69,984       $ 73,930       $ 78,683   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 89,890       $ 93,328       $ 72,662   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 68,821       $ 66,874       $ 64,146   

High Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 2,603   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 169,120       $ 159,698       $ 46,793   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 8,032   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 26,283       $ 26,128       $ 26,000   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 74,271       $ 73,866       $ 73,668   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 8,032   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 26,284       $ 26,151       $ 23,027   

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 84,310       $ 77,582       $ 76,676   

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 170,978       $ 171,635       $ 159,889   

 

105


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 184,672       $ 159,109       $ 108,490   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 81,480       $ 81,703       $ 74,147   

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 187,866       $ 191,276       $ 198,744   

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,280   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 107,431       $ 105,618       $ 103,264   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (the Distributor) serves as the principal underwriter and distributor for the continuous offering of shares of the Funds pursuant to a Distribution Agreement. The Distribution Agreement obligates the Distributor to use appropriate efforts to find purchasers for the shares of the Funds. The Distributor’s address is: One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111.

Distribution Obligations

Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, as agent, sells shares of the Funds on a continuous basis and transmits purchase and redemption orders that it receives to the Trust or the Transfer Agent, or their designated agents. Additionally, the Distributor has agreed to use appropriate efforts to solicit orders for the sale of shares and to undertake advertising and promotion as it believes appropriate in connection with such solicitation. Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, at its own expense, finances those activities which are primarily intended to result in the sale of shares of the Funds, including, but not limited to, advertising, compensation of underwriters, dealers and sales personnel, the printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than existing shareholders, and the printing and mailing of sales literature. The Distributor, however, may be compensated or reimbursed for all or a portion of such expenses to the extent permitted by a Distribution Plan adopted by the Trust pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Distribution and Servicing Plans for more information about the share classes for which the Trust has adopted a Distribution Plan.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

The Distribution Agreement became effective with respect to each Fund after approval by its Board, and, after an initial two-year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Distribution Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Distribution Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to each Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Distributor on 60 days’ written notice.

 

106


Table of Contents

 

Underwriting Commissions Paid by the Funds

The Previous Distributor received commissions and other compensation for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show amounts paid to the Previous Distributor, as well as amounts the Previous Distributor retained, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Convertible Securities Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 44,314       $ 45,753       $ 112,195   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 6,663       $ 7,725       $ 19,691   

Class B shares

   $ 15,863       $ 64,574       $ 117,174   

Class C shares

   $ 141       $ 2,957       $ 4,789   

Global Value Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 5       $ 534       $ 516   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —         $ 77       $ 74   

Class B shares

   $ 2,301       $ 15,805       $ 22,822   

Class C shares

     —         $ 58       $ 368   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Class R shares

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 15       $ 446         —     

Class B shares

   $ 4,216       $ 14,227         —     

Large Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 153,445       $ 178,936       $ 353,351   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 25,081       $ 29,956       $ 60,814   

Class B shares

   $ 57,696       $ 221,885       $ 492,464   

Class C shares

   $ 1,728       $ 2,847       $ 6,649   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 813,469       $ 4,159,043       $ 12,947,491   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 120,518       $ 683,537       $ 2,024,258   

Class B shares

   $ 402,871       $ 516,184       $ 289,032   

Class C shares

   $ 144,216       $ 531,406       $ 345,480   

 

107


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Marsico Global Fund**

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 12,606       $ 6,062         N/A   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,779       $ 696         N/A   

Class C shares

   $ 743       $ 606         N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 69,193       $ 302,677       $ 895,581   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 10,762       $ 54,459       $ 172,178   

Class B shares

   $ 38,709       $ 72,437       $ 46,425   

Class C shares

   $ 4,361       $ 20,577       $ 18,926   

Mid Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 267,654       $ 770,465       $ 2,497,114   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 45,628       $ 127,913       $ 404,357   

Class B shares

   $ 88,854       $ 191,561       $ 281,240   

Class C shares

   $ 20,739       $ 82,583       $ 69,456   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 13,134       $ 29,574       $ 56,978   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 2,007       $ 4,955       $ 10,323   

Class B shares

   $ 1,146       $ 2,895       $ 4,383   

Class C shares

     —         $ 155       $ 794   

Overseas Value Fund***

        

Amount Paid

     —           —           N/A   

Amount Retained

     —           —           N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     —           —           —     

 

108


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008*
 

Small Cap Value Fund II

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 8,583       $ 69,290       $ 369,025   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,118       $ 13,657       $ 59,495   

Class B shares

   $ 8,191       $ 13,646       $ 7,183   

Class C shares

   $ 1,745       $ 18,619       $ 11,554   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no underwriting commissions prior to that date.
*** Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no underwriting commissions prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

International Value Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 242,634       $ 684       $ 3,365       $ 4,037   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 34,160       $ 123       $ 514       $ 2,873   

Class B shares

   $ 507       $ 6,436       $ 21,443       $ 68,082   

Class C shares

   $ 827       $ 241       $ 246       $ 2,382   

Large Cap Core Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 42,420       $ 51,581       $ 55,167       $ 63,329   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 6,503       $ 8,300       $ 7,051       $ 9,738   

Class B shares

   $ 3,239       $ 4,423       $ 7,596       $ 12,538   

Class C shares

   $ 203       $ 128       $ 1,173       $ 3   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 264,977       $ 416,549       $ 789,688       $ 1,182,320   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 44,751       $ 70,078       $ 120,841       $ 181,454   

Class B shares

   $ 118,597       $ 207,952       $ 205,714       $ 390,545   

Class C shares

   $ 24,741       $ 58,825       $ 57,001       $ 76,216   

Marsico Growth Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 341,752       $ 577,560       $ 1,548,919       $ 1,901,364   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 66,515       $ 93,405       $ 219,479       $ 293,009   

Class B shares

   $ 119,246       $ 215,743       $ 130,863       $ 223,664   

Class C shares

   $ 43,937       $ 157,908       $ 105,184       $ 145,140   

 

109


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007*
 

Small Cap Growth Fund II

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 21,406       $ 38,170       $ 64,488       $ 66,395   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 12,949       $ 3,046       $ 6,108       $ 10,204   

Class B shares

   $ 1,948       $ 6,115       $ 11,977       $ 21,722   

Class C shares

   $ 551       $ 795       $ 1,423       $ 513   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 18,211       $ 23,096       $ 40,023   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 2,904       $ 3,460       $ 6,401   

Class B shares

   $ 502       $ 6,156       $ 4,775   

Class C shares

   $ 12       $ 350       $ 115   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Shares

     —           —           —     

High Income Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 159,763       $ 109,439       $ 193,929   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 19,213       $ 18,628       $ 23,028   

Class B shares

   $ 28,742       $ 70,082       $ 154,792   

Class C shares

   $ 5,225       $ 4,660       $ 4,914   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 707,466       $ 824,098       $ 1,678,950   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 112,738       $ 132,234       $ 288,116   

Class B shares

   $ 220,799       $ 479,481       $ 556,817   

Class C shares

   $ 6,080       $ 56,297       $ 30,593   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 357,761       $ 619,512       $ 1,467,904   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 54,808       $ 99,409       $ 252,171   

Class B shares

   $ 109,835       $ 230,340       $ 294,499   

Class C shares

   $ 6,240       $ 14,107       $ 28,334   

 

110


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 161,707       $ 248,920       $ 376,066   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 27,891       $ 45,674       $ 63,391   

Class B shares

   $ 43,762       $ 137,664       $ 125,774   

Class C shares

   $ 2,141       $ 9,112       $ 7,352   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 12,780       $ 20,370       $ 28,029   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,355       $ 1,738       $ 2,616   

Class B shares

   $ 6,709       $ 5,919       $ 11,651   

Class C shares

   $ 145       $ 1,609       $ 26   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 22,038       $ 125,854       $ 385,492   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 17,969       $ 21,250       $ 66,088   

Class B shares

   $ 14,287       $ 19,308       $ 17,122   

Class C shares

   $ 588       $ 6,443       $ 7,687   

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

        

Amount Paid

        

Shares

     —           —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 243,246       $ 70,381       $ 10,094   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 99,958       $ 19,312       $ 2,260   

Class B shares

   $ 4,116       $ 2,819       $ 4,984   

Class C shares

   $ 33,731       $ 14,417       $ 1,919   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 338,947       $ 163,550       $ 145   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 262,334       $ 56,320       $ 32   

Class B shares

     —           —           —     

Class C shares

   $ 30,159       $ 4,996       $ 203   

Total Return Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 16,557       $ 14,461       $ 7,265   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 1,585       $ 1,258       $ 795   

Class B shares

   $ 2,468       $ 8,232       $ 7,327   

Class C shares

   $ 420       $ 278       $ 600   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

111


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Period Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Period Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 13,765       $ 13,086       $ 1,585   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 4,013       $ 21,316       $ 162   

Class B shares

   $ 991       $ 1,377       $ 540   

Class C shares

   $ 828       $ 406         —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 32,915       $ 4,631       $ 7,927   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 3,025       $ 454       $ 839   

Class B shares

   $ 582         —         $ 2,301   

Class C shares

   $ 462         —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 71,197       $ 31,838       $ 11,083   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 6,775       $ 3,179       $ 1,176   

Class B shares

   $ 485       $ 283       $ 654   

Class C shares

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 31,713       $ 21,324       $ 6,097   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 13,321       $ 2,537       $ 669   

Class B shares

   $ 713       $ 229       $ 2,893   

Class C shares

   $ 409         —         $ 263   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 53,622       $ 18,959       $ 4,052   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 24,755       $ 7,258       $ 345   

Class B shares

     —           —         $ 1,134   

Class C shares

   $ 322       $ 141       $ 1,210   

Virginia Municipal Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 28,594       $ 22,633       $ 21,118   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 3,230       $ 2,300       $ 2,173   

Class B shares

   $ 698       $ 97       $ 1.746   

Class C shares

   $ 970       $ 947       $ 21   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

112


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

  Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

As described above in the Investment Advisory and Other Services section of this SAI, and in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Adviser, Administrator, Distributor and Transfer Agent, all affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, receive compensation from the Funds for the various services they provide to the Funds. Additional information as to the specific terms regarding such compensation is set forth in these affiliated service providers’ contracts with the Funds, each of which typically is included as an exhibit to Part C of each Fund’s registration statement.

In many instances, the compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for the services they provide to the Funds is based, in some manner, on the size of the Funds’ assets under management. As the size of the Funds’ assets under management grows, so does the amount of compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for providing services to the Funds. This relationship between Fund assets and affiliated service provider compensation may create economic and other conflicts of interests of which Fund investors should be aware. These potential conflicts of interest, as well as additional ones, are discussed in detail below and also are addressed in other disclosure materials, including the Funds’ prospectuses. These conflicts of interest also are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials of Ameriprise Financial affiliates that make available or offer the Columbia Funds as investments in connection with their respective products and services. In addition, Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV, which it must file with the SEC as an investment adviser registered under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, provides information about the Adviser’s business, assets under management, affiliates and potential conflicts of interest. Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV is available online through the SEC’s website at www.adviserinfo.sec.gov.

Additional actual or potential conflicts of interest and certain investment activity limitations that could affect the Funds may arise from the financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including, for example, the investment advisory/management services provided for clients and customers other than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial is a major financial services company. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are engaged in a wide range of financial activities beyond the mutual fund-related activities of the Adviser, including, among others, broker/dealer (sales and trading), asset management, insurance and other financial activities. The broad range of financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may involve multiple advisory, transactional, lending, financial and other interests in securities and other instruments, and in companies, that may be bought, sold or held by the Funds. The following describes certain actual and potential conflicts of interest that may be presented.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to the Investment Advisory/Management Activities of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates in Connection With Other Advised/Managed Funds and Accounts

The Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may advise or manage funds and accounts other than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may provide investment advisory/management and other services to other advised/managed funds and accounts that are similar to those provided to the Funds. The Adviser and Ameriprise Financial’s other investment adviser affiliates (including, for example, Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC) will give advice to and make decisions for all advised/managed funds and accounts, including the Funds, as they believe to be in that fund’s and/or account’s best interests, consistent with their fiduciary duties. The Funds and the other advised/managed funds and accounts of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are separately and potentially divergently managed, and there is no assurance that any investment advice Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates give to other advised/managed funds and accounts will also be given simultaneously or otherwise to the Funds.

A variety of other actual and potential conflicts of interest may arise from the advisory relationships of the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates with other clients and customers. Advice given to the Funds and/or investment decisions made for the Funds by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may differ from, or may conflict with, advice given to and/or investment decisions made for other advised/managed

 

113


Table of Contents

funds and accounts. As a result, the performance of the Funds may differ from the performance of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. Similarly, a position taken by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, on behalf of other funds or accounts may be contrary to a position taken on behalf of the Funds. Moreover, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may take a position on behalf of other advised/managed funds and accounts, or for their own proprietary accounts, that is adverse to companies or other issuers in which the Funds are invested. For example, the Funds may hold equity securities of a company while another advised/managed fund or account may hold debt securities of the same company. If the portfolio company were to experience financial difficulties, it might be in the best interest of the Funds for the company to reorganize while the interests of the other advised/managed fund or account might be better served by the liquidation of the company. This type of conflict of interest could arise as the result of circumstances that cannot be generally foreseen within the broad range of investment advisory/management activities in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates engage.

Investment transactions made on behalf of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates also may have a negative effect on the value, price or investment strategies of the Funds. For example, this could occur if another advised/managed fund or account implements an investment decision ahead of, or at the same time as, the Funds and causes the Funds to experience less favorable trading results than they otherwise would have experienced based on market liquidity factors. In addition, the other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, including the other Columbia Funds, may have the same or very similar investment objective and strategies as the Funds. In this situation, the allocation of, and competition for, investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and/or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may create conflicts of interest especially where, for example, limited investment availability is involved. The Adviser has adopted policies and procedures addressing the allocation of investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and accounts advised by the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

Sharing of Information among Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may possess information that could be material to the management of a Fund and may not be able to, or may determine not to, share that information with the Fund, even though the information might be beneficial to the Fund. This information may include actual knowledge regarding the particular investments and transactions of other advised/managed funds and accounts, as well as proprietary investment, trading and other market research, analytical and technical models, and new investment techniques, strategies and opportunities. Depending on the context, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will have no obligation to share any such information with the Funds. In general, employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the portfolio managers of the Adviser, will make investment decisions without regard to information otherwise known by other employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and generally will have no obligation to access any such information and may, in some instances, not be able to access such information because of legal and regulatory constraints or the internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For example, if the Adviser or another Ameriprise Financial affiliate, or their respective employees, come into possession of non-public information regarding another advised/managed fund or account, they may be prohibited by legal and regulatory constraints, or internal policies and procedures, from using that information in connection with transactions made on behalf of the Funds. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

Soft Dollar Benefits

Certain products and services, commonly referred to as “soft dollar services” (including, to the extent permitted by law, research reports, economic and financial data, financial publications, proxy analysis, computer

 

114


Table of Contents

databases and other research-oriented materials), that the Adviser may receive in connection with brokerage services provided to a Fund may have the inadvertent effect of disproportionately benefiting other advised/managed funds or accounts. This could happen because of the relative amount of brokerage services provided to a Fund as compared to other advised/managed funds or accounts, as well as the relative compensation paid by a Fund.

Services Provided to Other Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may act as an investment adviser, investment manager, administrator, transfer agent, custodian, trustee, broker/dealer, agent, or in another capacity, for advised/managed funds and accounts other than the Funds, and may receive compensation for acting in such capacity. This compensation that the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates receive could be greater than the compensation Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates receive for acting in the same or similar capacity for the Funds. In addition, the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may receive other benefits, including enhancement of new or existing business relationships. This compensation and/or the benefits that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may receive from other advised/managed funds and accounts and other relationships could potentially create incentives to favor other advised/managed funds and accounts over the Funds. Trades made by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates for the Funds may be, but are not required to be, aggregated with trades made for other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. If trades are aggregated among the Funds and those other funds and accounts, the various prices of the securities being traded may be averaged, which could have the potential effect of disadvantaging the Funds as compared to the other funds and accounts with which trades were aggregated.

Proxy Voting

Although the Adviser endeavors to make all proxy voting decisions with respect to the interests of the Funds for which it is responsible in accordance with its proxy voting policies and procedures, the Adviser’s proxy voting decisions with respect to a Fund’s portfolio securities may nonetheless benefit other advised/managed funds and accounts, and/or clients, of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. The Adviser has adopted proxy voting policies and procedures that are designed to provide that all proxy voting is done in the best interests of its clients, including the Funds, without any resulting benefit or detriment to the Adviser and/or its affiliates, including Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For more information about the Adviser’s proxy voting policies and procedures, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures.

Certain Trading Activities

The directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may buy and sell securities or other investments for their own accounts, and in doing so may take a position that is adverse to the Funds. In order to reduce the possibility that such personal investment activities of the directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates will materially adversely affect the Funds, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have adopted policies and procedures, and the Funds, the Board, the Adviser and the Distributor have each adopted a Code of Ethics that addresses such personal investment activities. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Codes of Ethics.

Affiliate Transactions

Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may enter into transactions in which Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates, or companies that are deemed to be affiliates of a Fund because of, among other factors, their or their affiliates’ ownership or control of shares of the Fund, may have an interest that potentially conflicts with the interests of the Fund. For example, an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial may sell securities to a Fund from an offering in which it is an underwriter or that it owns as a dealer, subject to applicable

 

115


Table of Contents

legal and regulatory requirements. Applicable legal and regulatory requirements also may prevent a Fund from engaging in transactions with an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, or from participating in an investment opportunity in which an affiliate of a Fund participates.

Certain Investment Limitations

Regulatory and other restrictions may limit a Fund’s investment activities in various ways. For example, regulations regarding certain industries and markets, such as emerging or international markets, and certain transactions, such as those involving certain futures and derivatives as well as restrictions applicable to certain issuers (e.g., poison pills), may impose limits on the aggregate amount of investments that may be made by affiliated investors, including accounts owned or managed by the same or affiliated managers, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. In these circumstances, the Adviser may be prevented from acquiring securities for a Fund that it might otherwise prefer to acquire if the acquisition would cause the Fund and its affiliated investors to exceed an applicable limit. These types of regulatory and other applicable limits are complex and vary significantly in different contexts including, among others, from country to country, industry to industry and issuer to issuer. The Adviser has procedures in place designed to monitor potential conflicts arising from regulatory and other limits. Nonetheless, given the complexity of these limits, the Adviser and its affiliates may inadvertently breach these limits, and a Fund may therefore be required to sell securities that it might otherwise prefer to hold in order to comply with such limits. At certain times, a Fund may be restricted in its investment activities because of relationships that an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, may have with the issuers of securities. This could happen, for example, if a Fund desired to buy a security issued by a company for which Ameriprise Financial or an affiliate serves as underwriter. The internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates covering these types of restrictions and addressing similar issues also may at times restrict a Fund’s investment activities. See also About the Funds’ Investments – Certain Investment Activity Limits.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates’ Non-Advisory Relationships with Clients and Customers other than the Funds

The financial relationships that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may have with companies and other entities in which a Fund may invest can give rise to actual and potential conflicts of interest. Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may invest (a) in the securities of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or in companies in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have an equity, debt or other interest, and/or (b) in the securities of companies held by other Columbia Funds. The purchase, holding and sale of such securities by a Fund may enhance the profitability and the business interests of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or other Columbia Funds. There also may be limitations as to the sharing with the Adviser of information derived from the non-investment advisory/management activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates because of legal and regulatory constraints and internal policies and procedures (such as information barriers and ethical walls). Because of these limitations, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will not share information derived from its non-investment advisory/management activities with the Adviser.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial Affiliates’ Marketing and Use of the Columbia Funds as Investment Options

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also provide a variety of products and services that, in some manner, may utilize the Columbia Funds as investment options. For example, the Columbia Funds may be offered as investments in connection with brokerage and other securities products offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and may be utilized as investments in connection with fiduciary, investment management and other accounts offered by affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, as well as for other Columbia Funds structured as “funds of funds.” The use of the Columbia Funds in connection with other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may introduce economic and other conflicts of interest. These conflicts of interest are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials for the other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates.

 

116


Table of Contents

 

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may make payments to their affiliates in connection with the promotion and sale of the Funds’ shares, in addition to the sales-related and other compensation that these parties may receive from the Funds. As a general matter, personnel of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, do not receive compensation in connection with their sales or use of the Funds that is greater than that paid in connection with their sales of other comparable products and services. Nonetheless, because the compensation that the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may receive for providing services to the Funds is generally based on the Funds’ assets under management and those assets will grow as shares of the Funds are sold, potential conflicts of interest may exist. See Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Financial Intermediary Payments for more information.

Other Services Provided

The Transfer Agent

Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly, RiverSource Service Corporation) is the transfer agent for the Funds. The Transfer Agent is located at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111. Under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Transfer Agent provides transfer agency, dividend disbursing agency and shareholder servicing agency services to the Funds. Effective September 7, 2010, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, pay the Transfer Agent an annual transfer agency fee of $12.08 per account, payable monthly for all share classes, except for Class I shares, and, prior to September 7, 2010, paid the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) an annual transfer agency fee of $22.36 per account, payable monthly.

In addition, effective September 7, 2010, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds in an annual amount equal to 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in such omnibus accounts (other than omnibus accounts for which American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc. is the broker of record or accounts where the beneficial owner is a customer of Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., for which the Transfer Agent is reimbursed $16.00 annually, calculated monthly based on the total number of positions in such accounts at the end of such month) for all share classes, except for Class I, Class R4, and Class Y shares. For Class R4 shares, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds subject to an annual limitation of 0.05% of the net assets attributable to such shares. Prior to September 7, 2010, the Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, reimbursed the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent paid to financial intermediaries that maintained omnibus accounts with the Funds, subject to a cap of up to $22.36 per account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent on a per account basis and a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by such an account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent based on a percentage of net assets.

The Funds, except for Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, and LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio, also pay certain reimbursable out-of-pocket expenses of the Transfer Agent. The Transfer Agent also may retain as additional compensation for its services revenues for fees for wire, telephone and redemption orders, IRA trustee agent fees and account transcripts due the Transfer Agent from Fund shareholders and credits (net of bank charges) earned with respect to balances in accounts the Transfer Agent maintains in connection with its services to the Funds.

 

117


Table of Contents

 

For the period January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2009, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual transfer agency fee of $17.34 per account, payable monthly. In addition, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid for the fees and expenses the Previous Transfer Agent paid to third party dealer firms that maintained omnibus accounts with certain of the Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account. For the period April 1, 2006 through December 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual fee of $17.00 per account, payable monthly. For the period November 1, 2005 through March 31, 2006, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual fee of $15.23 per account, payable monthly. For the period September 1, 2005 through December 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was entitled to reimbursement by certain Funds for the fees and expenses that the Previous Transfer Agent paid to dealer firms or transfer agents that maintained omnibus accounts with such Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.11% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account.

The Funds that offer Class R4 shares have a Plan Administration Services Agreement with the Transfer Agent. Under the agreement, the Funds pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and Health Savings Accounts (HSAs). The fee for services is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of the average daily net assets of each Fund attributable to Class R4 shares.

Transfer agency costs for each Fund are calculated separately for each of (i) Class Y shares, (ii) Class R4 shares and (iii) all other share classes (except Class I shares, which pay no transfer agency fees). The fees paid to the Transfer Agent may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval.

The Transfer Agent retains BFDS/DST, 2 Heritage Drive, North Quincy, MA 02171 as the Funds’ sub-transfer agent. BFDS/DST assists the Transfer Agent in carrying out its duties.

The Custodian

State Street, which is located at State Street Financial Center, One Lincoln Street, Boston, MA 02111, is the Funds’ Custodian. State Street is responsible for safeguarding the Funds’ cash and securities, receiving and delivering securities and collecting the Funds’ interest and dividends.

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, which is located at 125 High Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the Funds’ independent registered public accounting firm. The Funds issue unaudited financial statements semi-annually and audited financial statements annually. The financial statements for the fiscal years ended on or after March 31, 2010 contained in a Fund’s Annual Report were audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. The Board has selected PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as the independent registered public accounting firm to audit the Funds’ books and review their tax returns for the fiscal years ended on or after March 31, 2011.

The Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements are included in the annual reports to shareholders of the Funds, and are incorporated herein by reference. No other parts of the annual reports or semi-annual reports to shareholders are incorporated by reference herein. The financial statements incorporated by reference into the Funds’ prospectuses and this SAI have been so incorporated in reliance upon the report of the independent registered public accounting firm, given on its authority as an expert in auditing and accounting.

Counsel

Goodwin Procter LLP serves as legal counsel to the Trust. Its address is 901 New York Avenue N.W., Washington, DC, 20001.

 

118


Table of Contents

 

Distribution and Servicing Plans

The Trust has adopted distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans for the Class B shares, Class C shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares and Class W shares of the Funds and a combined shareholder servicing and distribution plan for Class A shares. See Capital Stock and Other Securities for information about which Funds offer which classes of shares. The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in any such shares. See the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds for details.

The table below shows the annual distribution and/or services fees (payable monthly and calculated based on an annual percentage of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees applicable to each share class:

 

      Distribution
Fee
    Service
Fee
    Combined
Total
 

Class A

     none        none        0.25 %* 

Class B

     0.75     0.25     1.00

Class C

     0.75     0.25     1.00 %a 

Class I

     none        none        none   

Class R

     0.50     b      0.50

Class R4

     none        0.25 %c      0.25 %c 

Class W

     0.25     0.25     0.25

Class Y

     none        none        none   

Class Z

     none        none        none   

 

* The Funds pay a combined distribution and service fee pursuant to their combined shareholder servicing and distribution plan for Class A shares.
a

The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares of Short Term Bond Fund so that the distribution fee does not exceed 0.31% annually and the combined distribution and service fee does not exceed 0.56% annually. This arrangement may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

b

Class R shares pay a distribution fee pursuant to a Fund’s distribution (Rule 12b-1) plan for Class R shares. The Funds do not have a shareholder service plan for Class R shares.

c

The shareholder service fees for Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a Plan Administration Services Agreement, the Funds’ Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up. and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

The shareholder servicing plans permit the Funds to compensate or reimburse servicing agents for the shareholder services they have provided. The distribution plans, adopted pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, permit the Funds to compensate or reimburse the Distributor and/or selling agents for activities or expenses primarily intended to result in the sale of the classes’ shares. Payments are made at an annual rate and paid monthly, as a percentage of average daily net assets, set from time to time by the Board, and are charged as expenses of each Fund directly to the applicable share class. A substantial portion of the expenses incurred pursuant to these plans may be paid to affiliates of the Distributor and Ameriprise Financial.

Under the shareholder servicing plan, the Board must review, at least quarterly, a written report of the amounts paid under the servicing agreements and the purposes for which those expenditures were made. The initial term of the shareholder servicing plan is one year and it will continue in effect from year to year after its initial one-year term provided that its continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a majority of the Board, including a majority of the Independent Trustees who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the shareholder servicing plan or in any agreement related to it. Any material amendment to the

 

119


Table of Contents

shareholder servicing plan must be approved in the same manner. The shareholder servicing plan is terminable at any time with respect to the Funds by a vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees.

The Trustees believe the distribution plans could be a significant factor in the growth and retention of a Fund’s assets resulting in more advantageous expense ratios and increased investment flexibility which could benefit each class of Fund shareholders. The distribution plans will continue in effect from year to year so long as continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a vote of the Trustees, including the Independent Trustees. The distribution plans may not be amended to increase the fee materially without approval by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares, and all material amendments of the distribution plans must be approved by the Trustees in the manner provided in the foregoing sentence. The distribution plans may be terminated at any time by vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares.

Distribution and Service Fees Paid by the Funds

The Previous Distributor received distribution and service fees from the Funds for its services as reflected in the following charts, which show distribution and service fees paid to and waived by the Previous Distributor for the most recently completed fiscal year, except as otherwise indicated. The Trust is not aware as to what amount, if any, of the distribution and service fees paid to the Distributor and Previous Distributor were, on a Fund-by-Fund basis, used for advertising, printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than current shareholders, compensation to broker-dealers, compensation to sales personnel, or interest, carrying or other financing charges. Class Y shares and Class Z shares do not pay distribution and service fees.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended February 28, 2010*

 

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Convertible Securities Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 452,015         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 217,252       $ 151,485         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 72,417       $ 50,495         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Global Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 43,756         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 60,336       $ 175,288         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 20,112       $ 58,429         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

International Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 839,422         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 117,908       $ 471,362         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 39,414       $ 157,299         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

 

120


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Large Cap Core Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 308,472         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 25,822       $ 16,769         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 8,610       $ 5,586         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 29,925         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         N/A       $ 365   

Service Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         N/A         —     

Large Cap Index Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 450,571         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 28,498         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 9,500         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           N/A         N/A   

Large Cap Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 2,116,593         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 931,465       $ 278,193       $ 1,043   

Service Fee

     —         $ 310,488       $ 92,731         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Marsico 21st Century Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 5,312,864         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 865,694       $ 5,219,447       $ 229,926   

Service Fee

     —         $ 288,564       $ 1,739,815         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 3,765,167         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 520,025       $ 2,265,084         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 173,342       $ 755,028         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Marsico Global Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 4,057         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 8,834       $ 4,318   

Service Fee

     —           N/A       $ 2,945         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           —     

Marsico Growth Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 4,043,631         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 377,764       $ 3,184,187       $ 65,356   

Service Fee

     —         $ 125,921       $ 1,061,396         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

 

121


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 554,223         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 141,837       $ 353,171       $ 15,664   

Service Fee

     —         $ 47,279       $ 117,724         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Mid Cap Index Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 297,022         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Mid Cap Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 3,275,124         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 555,246       $ 1,337,147       $ 1,054,475   

Service Fee

     —         $ 183,887       $ 443,036         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 58,172         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 9,896       $ 13,300       $ 992   

Service Fee

     —         $ 3,299       $ 4,433         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Overseas Value Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         —           —     

Service Fee

     —           N/A         —           —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 295,265         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 27,741       $ 19,673         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 9,242       $ 6,551         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 166,219         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         N/A         N/A   

Small Cap Value Fund II

           

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 869,827         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 22,185       $ 188,396       $ 103,273   

Service Fee

     —         $ 7,388       $ 62,797         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

 

122


Table of Contents

 

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2010*

 

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares      Shares  

Asset Allocation Fund II

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 169,852         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 17,494       $ 5,233         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 5,831       $ 1,744         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 43,341         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 1,855       $ 11,515         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 618       $ 3,839         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 43,782         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 9,036       $ 22,158         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 3,015       $ 7,386         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

High Income Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 248,940         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 280,926       $ 168,507         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 93,642       $ 56,169         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 546,946         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 1,354,042       $ 596,938       $ 9,178         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 451,347       $ 198,979         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 391,736         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 671,947       $ 471,008       $ 6,656         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 223,982       $ 157,003         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

 

123


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares      Shares  

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 136,936         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 322,250       $ 161,951       $ 2,344         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 107,417       $ 54,049         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 33,338         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 56,642       $ 41,333         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 18,891       $ 13,781         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 64,534         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 11,470       $ 19,721         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 3,828       $ 6,571         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 138,968         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 29,802       $ 82,039       $ 150         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 9,938       $ 27,350         —           N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           N/A   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 71,879         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 12,236       $ 28,699         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 4,079       $ 9,566         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Short Term Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 467,584         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 76,368       $ 532,171         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 25,456       $ 177,390         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

 

124


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares      Shares  

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 940,719         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 3,281       $ 381,034         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 1,094       $ 127,022         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 58,148         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 12,402       $ 58,377         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 4,126       $ 19,458         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Total Return Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 48,959         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 35,210       $ 29,886         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 11,737       $ 9,962         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

              

Combined Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Fee

   $ 127,074         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 14,232       $ 16,153         N/A         N/A   

Service Fee

     —         $ 4,759       $ 5,385         N/A         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A   

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

The Distributor may use the entire amount of its fees to defray the costs of commissions and service fees paid to selling and/or servicing agents and for certain other purposes. Since the distribution and service fees are payable regardless of the Distributor’s expenses, the Distributor may realize a profit from the fees. The distribution plans authorize any other payments by the Funds to the Distributor and its affiliates (including the Adviser) to the extent that such payments might be construed to be indirectly financing the distribution of a Fund’s shares. There were no unreimbursed expenses incurred under the distribution plans in the previous fiscal year to be carried over to the current fiscal year.

The Funds participate in joint distribution activities with other Columbia Funds. The fees paid under a distribution plan adopted by a Fund may be used to finance the distribution of the shares of other Columbia Funds. Such distribution costs are allocated based on the relative net asset size of the respective Funds.

Expense Limitations

The Adviser has voluntarily agreed to reimburse a portion of the Funds’ expenses so that the Funds’ ordinary operating expenses (excluding any distribution and service fees, brokerage commissions, interest, taxes

 

125


Table of Contents

and extraordinary expenses, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any) after giving effect to any balance credits from the Funds’ custodian, do not exceed the following percentages:

 

Fund

   Expenses as a Percent of
Average Daily Net Assets
on an  Annualized Basis
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended February 28

  

Convertible Securities Fund

     0.95

Global Value Fund*

     1.35

International Value Fund

     1.35

Large Cap Core Fund

     1.00

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund*

     0.70

Large Cap Index Fund*

     0.14

Large Cap Value Fund

     1.00

Marsico 21st Century Fund

     1.20

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

     1.20

Marsico Global Fund

     N/A   

Marsico Growth Fund

     1.20

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

     1.50

Mid Cap Index Fund

     0.20

Mid Cap Value Fund

     1.05

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

     1.35

Overseas Value Fund

     1.35

Small Cap Growth Fund II*

     1.10

Small Cap Index Fund*

     0.20

Small Cap Value Fund II*

     1.10

 

Fund

   Expenses as a Percent of
Average Daily Net Assets
on an  Annualized Basis
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

     0.95

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     N/A   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

High Income Fund

     1.00

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     N/A   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     0.00

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

     N/A   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Short Term Bond Fund

     0.48

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.50

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

Total Return Bond Fund*

     0.70

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund*

     0.55

 

* The Adviser is entitled to recover from the Fund any fees waived or expenses reimbursed for a three year period following the date of such waiver or reimbursement if such recovery does not cause the Fund’s expenses to exceed the expense limitations in effect at the time of recovery.

 

126


Table of Contents

 

These arrangements may be modified or terminated by the Adviser at any time.

For Short Term Bond Fund, the Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares so that it does not exceed 0.31% annually. This arrangement may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

Advisory Fee Waiver for Certain Funds – Period ending June 30, 2011

The Adviser has contractually agreed to waive a portion of the investment advisory fee for Marsico 21st Century Fund, Marsico Focused Equities Fund, Marsico International Opportunities Fund, Marsico Growth Fund and Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund through June 30, 2011 in an amount that is calculated based on the difference between the subadvisory fees that would have been payable to Marsico based on the subadvisory fee rates then in effect immediately prior to January 1, 2008 and the fees payable to Marsico under the current subadvisory fee rates. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Subadviser(s) and Investment Subadvisory Services for information on the subadvisory fee rates.

Advisory Fee Waiver for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio – Period ending July 31, 2011

The Adviser has contractually agreed to reimburse a portion of LifeGoal® Income Portfolio’s expenses through July 31, 2011 so that the Portfolio’s ordinary operating expenses (excluding any distribution and service fees, brokerage commissions, interest, taxes and extraordinary expenses, and expenses associated with the Portfolio’s investments in other investment companies, but including custodian charges relating to overdrafts, if any), after giving effect to any balance credits from the Portfolio’s custodian, do not exceed the following percentages:

 

Portfolio

   Expenses as a Percent of Average Daily Net Assets
on an Annualized Basis
 

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio (Portfolio-level commitment)

     0.42

Advisory/Administration Fee Waivers for LifeGoal® Income Portfolio – Period ending July 31, 2011

 

Portfolio

   Advisory Waivers     Administration Waivers  

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     0.10 %1      0.10 %2 

 

1

The Adviser shall waive advisory fees payable to it under the Investment Management Services Agreement on assets invested in individual securities, Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage-and Asset-Backed Portfolio.

2

The Adviser shall waive administration fees payable to it under the Administration Agreement on assets invested in other Columbia Funds (Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage-and Asset-Backed Portfolio are not considered Columbia Funds).

Codes of Ethics

The Funds, the Adviser, the subadvisers and the Distributor have adopted Codes of Ethics pursuant to the requirements of the 1940 Act, including Rule 17j–1 under the 1940 Act. These Codes of Ethics permit personnel subject to the Codes of Ethics to invest in securities, including securities that may be bought or held by the Funds. These Codes of Ethics are included as exhibits to Part C of the Funds’ registration statement. These Codes of Ethics can be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room and may be obtained by calling the SEC at 202.551.8090; they also are available on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, and may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request to publicinfo@sec.gov or by writing to the SEC’s Public Reference Section, Washington, D.C. 20549–1520.

 

127


Table of Contents

 

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

The Funds have delegated to the Adviser, or as applicable, the subadviser, the responsibility to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Funds. In deciding to delegate this responsibility to the Adviser, the Board reviewed and approved the policies and procedures adopted by the Adviser and, as applicable, a subadviser. These included the procedures that the Adviser follows when a vote presents a conflict between the interests of the Funds and their shareholders and the Adviser (or subadviser), its affiliates, its other clients or other persons.

The Adviser’s policy is to vote all proxies for Fund securities in a manner considered by the Adviser to be in the best interest of the Funds and their shareholders without regard to any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser examines each proposal and votes against the proposal, if, in its judgment, approval or adoption of the proposal would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities. The Adviser also examines each proposal and votes the proxies against the proposal, if, in its judgment, the proposal would be expected to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. The Adviser determines the best interest of the Funds in light of the potential economic return on each Fund’s investment.

The Adviser seeks to address potential material conflicts of interest by having predetermined voting guidelines. For those proposals that require special consideration or in instances where special circumstances may require varying from the predetermined guideline, the Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee determines the vote in the best interest of the Funds, without consideration of any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee is composed of representatives of the Adviser’s equity investments, equity research, compliance, legal and operations functions. In addition to the responsibilities described above, the Proxy Voting Committee has the responsibility to review, at least annually, the Adviser’s proxy voting policies to ensure consistency with internal policies and regulatory requirements and to develop additional predetermined voting guidelines to assist in the review of proxy proposals.

The Proxy Voting Committee may vary from a predetermined guideline if it determines that voting on the proposal according to the predetermined guideline would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities or to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. References to the best interests of the Funds refer to the interest of the Funds in terms of the potential economic return on the client’s investment. In determining the vote on any proposal, the Proxy Voting Committee does not consider any benefit other than benefits to the Funds. A member of the Proxy Voting Committee is prohibited from voting on any proposal for which he or she has a conflict of interest by reason of a direct relationship with the issuer or other party affected by a given proposal. Persons making recommendations to the Proxy Voting Committee or its members are required to disclose to the Committee any relationship with a party making a proposal or other matter known to the person that would create a potential conflict of interest.

The Adviser has retained Glass-Lewis & Co., a third-party vendor, to implement its proxy voting process. Glass-Lewis & Co. provides proxy analysis, record keeping services and vote disclosure services. Information regarding how the Columbia Funds (except certain Columbia Funds that do not invest in voting securities) voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent twelve month period ended June 30 will be available by August 31 of this year free of charge: (i) through the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com and (ii) on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. For a copy of the Adviser’s and subadvisers’ policies and procedures that are used to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Columbia Funds, see Appendix B to this SAI.

Expenses Paid by Third Parties

The Distributor and the Administrator furnish, without additional cost to the Funds, the services of certain officers of the Funds and such other personnel (other than the personnel of the Adviser or the investment

 

128


Table of Contents

subadviser(s), if applicable) as are required for the proper conduct of the Funds’ affairs. The Distributor bears the incremental expenses of printing and distributing prospectuses used by the Distributor or furnished by the Distributor to investors in connection with the public offering of the Funds’ shares and the costs of any other promotional or sales literature, except that to the extent permitted under the Distribution Plans of each Fund, sales-related expenses incurred by the Distributor may be reimbursed by the Funds.

The Funds pay or cause to be paid all other expenses of the Funds, including, without limitation: the fees of the Adviser, the Distributor and the Administrator; the charges and expenses of any registrar, any custodian or depository appointed by the Funds for the safekeeping of their cash, Fund securities and other property, and any stock transfer, dividend or accounting agent or agents appointed by the Funds; brokerage commissions chargeable to the Funds in connection with Fund securities transactions to which the Funds are a party; all taxes, including securities issuance and transfer taxes; corporate fees payable by the Funds to federal, state or other governmental agencies; all costs and expenses in connection with the registration and maintenance of registration of the Funds’ shares with the SEC and various states and other jurisdictions (including filing fees, legal fees and disbursements of counsel); the costs and expenses of preparing and typesetting prospectuses and statements of additional information of the Funds (including supplements thereto) and periodic reports and of printing and distributing such prospectuses and statements of additional information (including supplements thereto) to the Funds’ shareholders; all expenses of shareholders’ and Trustee meetings and of preparing, printing and mailing proxy statements and reports to shareholders; fees and travel expenses of directors or director members of any advisory board or committee; all expenses incident to the payment of any distribution, whether in shares or cash; charges and expenses of any outside service used for pricing of the Funds’ shares; fees and expenses of legal counsel and of independent auditors in connection with any matter relating to the Funds; membership dues of industry associations; interest payable on Fund borrowings; postage and long-distance telephone charges; insurance premiums on property or personnel (including officers and directors) of the Funds which inure to their benefit; extraordinary expenses (including, but not limited to, legal claims and liabilities and litigation costs and any indemnification related thereto); and all other charges and costs of the Funds’ operation unless otherwise explicitly assumed by the Adviser or the Administrator.

The Adviser has agreed to bear all fees and expenses of Corporate Bond Portfolio, Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio, LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio, LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio and LifeGoal® Growth and Income Portfolio except taxes, brokerage fees and commissions, costs, including interest expenses, of borrowing money, extraordinary expenses and any applicable 12b-1 fees, shareholder servicing fees and/or shareholder administration fees. The expenses borne by the Adviser include custodian, transfer agent, legal and audit fees and costs, expenses of issue, sale, redemption and repurchase of shares, expenses of registering and qualifying shares for sale, expenses relating to trustee and shareholder meetings, the cost of preparing and distributing reports and notices to shareholders, and the cost of preparing and printing prospectuses and SAIs distributed to the Portfolios’ shareholders. This assumption does not include advisory fees to the Adviser.

Expenses of the Funds which are not attributable to the operations of any class of shares or Fund are pro-rated among all classes of shares or certain Columbia Funds, including the Funds based upon the relative net assets of each class or Fund. Expenses which are not directly attributable to a specific class of shares but are attributable to a specific Fund are prorated among all the classes of shares of such Fund based upon the relative net assets of each such class of shares. Expenses which are directly attributable to a class of shares are charged against the income available for distribution as dividends to such class of shares.

 

129


Table of Contents

 

FUND GOVERNANCE

The Board

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

The Board oversees management of the Trust and the Funds. The Board has a duty to act in the best interest of shareholders when supervising and overseeing the management and operations of the Trust. The Board consists of seven Trustees who have extensive and varied experience and skills. Six of the Trustees are Independent Trustees. The Trust currently treats the remaining Trustee, Dr. Anthony M. Santomero, as an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Columbia Funds (the Interested Trustee) because he serves as a Director of Citigroup, Inc. and CitiBank N.A. companies that may engage from time-to-time in brokerage execution, principal transactions and lending relationships with the Funds or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser. Further information about the background and qualifications of each of the Trustees can be found in the section Trustee Biographical Information and Qualifications.

The Board has appointed an Independent Trustee to serve in the role of Chairman. The Chairman actively participates in the development of the agendas for Board meetings, presides at Board Meetings and acts as a liaison with service providers, officers, attorneys, and other Trustees generally between meetings. The Chairman may also perform such other functions as may be delegated by the Board from time to time. Except for any duties specified herein or pursuant to the Trust’s charter document, the designation of Chairman does not impose on such Independent Trustee any duties, obligations or liability that are greater than the duties, obligations or liability imposed on such person as a member of the Board generally.

The Board has several standing committees (the Committees), which are an integral part of the Funds’ overall governance and risk management oversight structure. The standing Committees are the Audit Committee, the Governance Committee, the Contracts Review Committee and the Investment Committee. The roles of each Committee are more fully described in the section Standing Committees below.

The Funds have retained the Adviser as the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator. The Adviser provides the Funds with investment advisory services, and is responsible for day-to-day management and administration of the Funds and management of the risks that arise from the Funds’ investments and operations. The Board is responsible for overseeing the Adviser and other service providers in the operation of the Trust, including with respect to risk management functions. The Funds and the Trust are subject to a number of risks, including investment, compliance, operational, and valuation risks, among others. Day-to-day risk management functions are subsumed within the responsibilities of the Adviser, the subadvisers and other service providers (depending on the nature of the risk), who carry out the Funds’ investment management and business affairs. Each of the Adviser, the subadvisers and other service providers have their own, independent interest in risk management, and their policies and methods of carrying out risk management functions will depend, in part, on their analysis of the risks, functions and business models.

Risk oversight forms part of the Board’s general oversight of the Funds and the Trust and is addressed as part of various Board and Committee activities. The Board recognizes that it is not possible to identify all of the risks that may affect a Fund or to develop processes and controls to eliminate or even mitigate their occurrence or effects. As part of its regular oversight of the Trust, the Board, directly or through a Committee, interacts with and reviews reports from, among others, the Adviser, subadvisers, the independent registered public accounting firm for the Fund, and internal auditors for the Adviser or its affiliates, as appropriate, regarding risks faced by the Funds and relevant risk functions. The Board and the Audit Committee also meet periodically with the Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, to receive reports regarding the compliance of the Funds and their principal service providers with the federal securities laws and their internal compliance policies and procedures. The Board and the Audit Committee review and approve the compliance program of the Fund and certain of its service providers, and also receive periodic and annual reports from the Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, as required under applicable regulations. The Board, with the assistance of the Investment Committee, reviews investment policies and risks in connection with its review of the Funds’ performance, and meets periodically

 

130


Table of Contents

with the portfolio managers of the Funds to receive reports regarding the management of the Funds, including their investment risks. In addition, as part of the Board’s periodic review of the Funds’ advisory, subadvisory and other service provider agreements, the Board may consider risk management aspects of their operations and the functions for which they are responsible.

The Independent Trustees have engaged independent legal counsel to assist them in performing their oversight responsibilities. The Board reviews its leadership structure periodically and believes that its structure is appropriate because it allows the Board to exercise informed and independent judgment over matters under its purview, and it allocates areas of responsibility among committees of Trustees and the full Board in a manner that enhances effective oversight. In particular, the Board believes that having an Independent Trustee serve as the chair of the Board and each Committee promotes independence from the Adviser in setting agendas and conducting meetings. The Board believes that its committee structure makes the oversight process more efficient and more effective by allowing smaller groups of Trustees to bring increased focus to matters within the purview of each Committee. The leadership structure of the Board, including the manner in which it conducts its risk oversight role, may be changed, at any time and in the discretion of the Board, including in response to changes in circumstances or the characteristics of the Trust.

Standing Committees

The Trust has four standing Committees, which are the Audit Committee, the Contracts Review Committee, the Governance Committee and the Investment Committee.

In general, the function of the Audit Committee is oversight of the financial aspects of the Trust and Funds and approval of and interaction with the Funds’ Independent Auditors. Management (which generally means the appropriate officers of the Trust, and a Fund’s investment adviser(s), administrator(s) and other key service providers (other than the independent registered public accounting firm)) is primarily responsible for the preparation of the financial statements of each Fund, and the independent registered public accounting firm is responsible for auditing those financial statements. Management also is responsible for maintaining appropriate systems for accounting and “internal controls over financial reporting” (as such term is defined in Rule 30a-3 under the 1940 Act), and the independent registered public accounting firm is primarily responsible for considering such internal controls over financial reporting in connection with its financial statement audits. While the Audit Committee has the duties and powers set forth in the Audit Committee charter, the Audit Committee is not responsible for planning or conducting any Fund audit or for determining whether a Fund’s financial statements are complete and accurate and are in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

The Audit Committee has, among other things, specific power and responsibility to: (i) oversee its Funds’ accounting and financial reporting processes and practices, its internal controls over financial reporting and, as appropriate, the internal controls over financial reporting of the Funds maintained by key service providers; (ii) approve, and recommend to the full Board for its approval in accordance with applicable law, the selection and appointment of an independent registered public accounting firm for the Fund prior to the engagement of such independent registered public accounting firm; (iii) pre-approve all audit and non-audit services provided to a Fund by its independent registered public accounting firm, directly or by establishing pre-approval policies and procedures pursuant to which such services may be rendered, provided however, that the policies and procedures are detailed as to the particular service and the Audit Committee is informed of each service, and such policies do not include the delegation to management of the Audit Committee’s responsibilities under the 1934 Act or applicable rules or listing requirements; and (iv) pre-approve all non-audit services provided by a Fund’s independent registered public accounting firm to the Fund’s investment adviser and any entity controlling, controlled by, or under common control with the investment adviser that provides ongoing services to a Fund, if the engagement relates directly to the operations and financial reporting of a Fund. The members of the Audit Committee are William A. Hawkins (Chair), Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. and William P. Carmichael. The Audit Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

 

131


Table of Contents

 

The primary responsibilities of the Contracts Review Committee, as set forth in its charter, include reviewing and making recommendations to the Board as to: (i) contractual arrangements; (ii) the factors considered in approving investment advisory and the investment subadvisory agreements; and (iii) service provider oversight and performance. Among other responsibilities, the Contracts Review Committee also oversees and coordinates activities of consultants and legal or financial experts that may be engaged under certain circumstances. The members of the Contracts Review Committee are R. Glenn Hilliard (Chair), William P. Carmichael, John J. Nagorniak and Anthony M. Santomero. With the exception of the Interested Trustee, the Contracts Review Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

The primary responsibilities of the Governance Committee include, as set forth in its charter: (i) nominating Independent Trustees; (ii) overseeing issues of corporate governance for the Trust and the Funds; (iii) addressing matters relating to compensation of Trustees who are not current directors, officers or employees of a Fund’s investment adviser or subadviser or any control affiliate thereof, including deferred compensation and retirement policies; and (iv) evaluating each Board and its committee structure as often as it deems necessary or desirable to determine whether each is functioning effectively. The Governance Committee shall determine the nature of the evaluation and its role therein in its sole discretion. The members of the Governance Committee are Minor M. Shaw (Chair), William A. Hawkins, R. Glenn Hilliard and William P. Carmichael (ex officio). The Governance Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

The primary responsibilities of the Investment Committee are, as set forth in its charter, to assist the Board in carrying out its oversight responsibilities in specific areas of investment management, both by acting as liaison between the full Board and the Adviser on investment matters, and by acting on behalf of the Board with respect to investment issues in extraordinary circumstances when it is impractical to convene a meeting of the full Board. In carrying out these general responsibilities, the Investment Committee assists the Board in connection with issues relating to: the investment policies and procedures adopted for each Fund; appropriate performance benchmarks and other comparative issues; portfolio management staffing and other personnel issues of the Adviser; investment related compliance issues; possible exemptive applications or other relief necessary or appropriate with respect to investment matters; and other investment related matters referred from time to time to the Committee by the full Board. The Committee reports its activities to the full Board on a regular basis and is responsible for making such recommendations with respect to the matters described above and other matters as the Committee may deem necessary or appropriate. The Chairperson of the Investment Committee is Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Each Trustee is a member of the Investment Committee. With the exception of the Interested Trustee, the Investment Committee members are all Independent Trustees.

The table below shows the number of times the committees met during each Fund’s most recent fiscal year. The table is organized by fiscal year end.

 

Fiscal Period

   Audit Committee      Contracts Review
Committee
     Governance
Committee
     Investment
Committee
 

For Funds with fiscal years ending February 28

     5         4         7         7   

For Funds with fiscal years ending March 31

     5         4         7         7   

The Trust’s Declaration of Trust does not set forth any specific qualifications to serve as a Trustee other than that each Trustee shall be an individual of at least 21 years of age who is not under a legal disability. The Charter of the Governance Committee also does not set forth any specific qualifications, but does set forth certain factors that the Committee may take into account in considering Trustee candidates. Among the attributes or skills common to all Trustees are their ability to review critically, evaluate, question and discuss information provided to them, to interact effectively with the other Trustees, the Adviser, subadvisers, other service providers, counsel and the independent registered public accounting firm, and to exercise effective and independent business judgment in the performance of their duties as Trustees. Each Trustee’s ability to perform his or her duties effectively has been attained through: (i) the individual’s business and professional experience and accomplishments; (ii) the individual’s experience working with the other Trustees and management; (iii) the

 

132


Table of Contents

individual’s prior experience, if any, serving on the boards of public companies (including, where relevant, other investment companies) and other complex enterprises and organizations; and (iv) his or her educational background, professional training, and/or other life experiences. Generally, no one factor was decisive in determining that an individual should serve as a Trustee.

Following is a summary of each Trustee’s particular professional and other experience that qualifies each person to serve as a Trustee of the Trust as of the date of this SAI:

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr. Mr. Boudreau has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2005. In addition, he has over thirty years of business and consulting experience, primarily in the financial services industry, including as the chief executive of a mutual fund management company.

William P. Carmichael. Mr. Carmichael has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 1999, and has served as Chairman of the Board of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2003. Mr. Carmichael served in various senior financial and directorship positions with global consumer products companies. Mr. Carmichael is a certified public accountant and a licensed attorney.

William A. Hawkins. Mr. Hawkins has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2005. He currently serves as the President and Chief Executive Officer of California General Bank and has over thirty years of executive level experience in the banking industry. Mr. Hawkins is a certified financial planner and a chartered property and casualty underwriter, as well as holding series 7, 24 and 63 licenses from the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

R. Glenn Hilliard. Mr. Hilliard has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2005. Mr. Hilliard is currently the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of The Hilliard Group, LLC. He has over twenty years executive level experience in the insurance industry. Mr. Hilliard has served on the Board of Directors and as non-executive chairman of Conseco, Inc. for a number of years. Mr. Hilliard is also a licensed attorney.

John J. Nagorniak. Mr. Nagorniak has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2008. Mr. Nagorniak has served in executive level and director positions for over twenty-five years. He is a chartered financial analyst and is currently a Trustee of the Research Foundation of the CFA Institute.

Minor M. Shaw. Ms. Shaw has served as a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2003. Ms. Shaw is the President of certain private companies and is a member of the Board of Piedmont Natural Gas and Blue Cross and Blue Shield of South Carolina. Ms. Shaw also serves as an active member on the boards of numerous educational and public service organizations.

Anthony M. Santomero. Dr. Santomero has been a Trustee of the Trust and of certain other trusts in the Columbia Funds Complex since 2008. Dr. Santomero has over thirty years of experience as a professor of finance and private consultant specializing in issues including risk management, financial restructuring, credit risk evaluation and management, and regulation. He has served as consultant to financial institutions and agencies in the U.S. and various countries in the European Union and the European Community itself, as well as institutions in various countries around the world. Additionally, Dr. Santomero has served as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia.

The following table provides additional biographical information about the Trustees as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period. The mailing address of each Trustee is: c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, One Financial Center, Mail Stop MA5-515-11-05, Boston, MA 02111.

 

133


Table of Contents

 

Independent Trustee Biographical Information

 

Name, Year of Birth and
Position Held with the Trust

 

Year First
Appointed or
Elected to a
Board in the
Columbia Funds
Complex

 

Principal
Occupation(s) During the
Past Five Years

  Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
   

Other Directorships Held
by Trustee During the
Past Five Years

Independent Trustees

       

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

(Born 1944)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since January 2005
  Managing Director – E.J. Boudreau & Associates (consulting), from 2000 through current     52      Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

William P. Carmichael

(Born 1943)

Trustee and Chairman of the Board

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since 1999
  Retired     52      Director – Cobra Electronics Corporation (electronic equipment manufacturer); Simmons Company (bedding); and The Finish Line (athletic shoes and apparel); Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios); former Director of Spectrum Brands, Inc. (consumer products)

William A. Hawkins

(Born 1942)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2005
  President and Chief Executive Officer – California Bank, N.A., from January 2008 through current     52      Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

R. Glenn Hilliard

(Born 1943)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2005
  Chairman and Chief Executive Officer – Hilliard Group LLC (investing and consulting), from April 2003 through current; Non-Executive Director & Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), September 2003 through current; Executive Chairman – Conseco, Inc. (insurance), August 2004 through September 2005     52      Director – Conseco, Inc. (insurance); Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

 

134


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and
Position Held with the Trust

 

Year First
Appointed or
Elected to a
Board in the
Columbia Funds
Complex

 

Principal
Occupation(s) During the
Past Five Years

  Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
 

Other Directorships Held
by Trustee During the
Past Five Years

John J. Nagorniak

(Born 1944)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2008
  Retired; President and Director – Foxstone Financial, Inc. (consulting), 2000 through December 2007; Director – Mellon Financial Corporation affiliates (investing), 2000 through 2007; Chairman – Franklin Portfolio Associates (investing – Mellon affiliate) 1982 through 2007   52   Trustee – Research Foundation of CFA Institute; Director – MIT Investment Company; Trustee – MIT 401k Plan; Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

Minor M. Shaw

(Born 1947)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
2003
  President – Micco Corporation and Mickel Investment Group   52   Board Member – Piedmont Natural Gas; Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

Interested Trustee Biographical Information

     

Anthony M. Santomero1

(Born 1946)

Trustee

  Indefinite term;
Trustee since
January 2008
  Richard K. Mellon Professor Emeritus of Finance, The Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, from 2002 through current; Senior Advisor – McKinsey & Company (consulting), 2006 through 2008; President and Chief Executive Officer – Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia, 2000 through 2006   52   Director – Renaissance Reinsurance Ltd.; Trustee – Penn Mutual Life Insurance Company; Director – Citigroup; Trustee – BofA Funds Series Trust (II Portfolios)

 

1

Dr. Santomero is currently deemed by the Columbia Funds to be an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds because he serves as a Director of Citigroup, Inc. and Citibank N.A., companies that may directly or through subsidiaries and affiliates engage from time-to-time in brokerage execution, principal transactions and lending relationships with the Columbia Funds or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser.

 

135


Table of Contents

 

Compensation

Trustees are compensated for their services to the Columbia Funds complex on a complex-wide basis, as shown in the table below.

 

     Aggregate Compensation from Fund  
     Independent Trustees  

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
   William P.
Carmichael2
     Minor  M.
Shaw3
     R.  Glenn
Hilliard4
     William  A.
Hawkins5
     John J.
Nagorniak6
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending February 28

              

Convertible Securities Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Global Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

International Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Core Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Index Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Large Cap Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico Global Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Overseas Value Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Small Cap Index Fund

   $4,608      $5,546         $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571      $0         $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

 

136


Table of Contents

 

     Aggregate Compensation from Fund  
     Independent Trustees  

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
   William P.
Carmichael2
   Minor  M.
Shaw3
     R.  Glenn
Hilliard4
     William  A.
Hawkins5
     John J.
Nagorniak6
 

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

              

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

High Income Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   N/A    N/A      N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Short Term Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546      $4,452         $4,530         $4,608         $3,908   

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0      $2,226         $0         $83         $1,173   

 

137


Table of Contents
     Aggregate Compensation from Fund
     Independent Trustees

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.1
   William P.
Carmichael2
   Minor M.
Shaw3
   R. Glenn
Hilliard4
   William A.
Hawkins5
   John J.
Nagorniak6

Total Return Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546    $4,452    $4,530    $4,608    $3,908

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0    $2,226    $0    $83    $1,173

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $4,608    $5,546    $4,452    $4,530    $4,608    $3,908

Amount deferred

   $1,571    $0    $2,226    $0    $83    $1,173

 

1

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Boudreau deferred $81,627 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Boudreau’s account under that plan was $286,846.

2

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Carmichael deferred $0 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Carmichael’s account under that plan was $1,056,273.

3

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Ms. Shaw deferred $132,587 of her total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Shaw’s account under that plan was $576,224.

4

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Hilliard deferred $31,154 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Hilliard’s account under that plan was $605,201.

5

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Hawkins deferred $0 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Hawkins’s account under that plan was $0.

6

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Nagorniak deferred $69,170 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Nagorniak’s account under that plan was $130,303.

 

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

      
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

For funds with fiscal year ending February 28

  

Convertible Securities Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Global Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

International Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Core Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Index Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Large Cap Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

138


Table of Contents

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

      
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico Global Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Overseas Value Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Small Cap Index Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

For funds with fiscal year ending March 31

  

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

High Income Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

139


Table of Contents

Aggregate Compensation from Fund

      
     Interested
Trustee
 

Fund

   Anthony  M.
Santomero7
 

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

     N/A   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Short Term Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Total Return Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   $ 4,139   

Amount deferred

   $ 1,931   

 

7

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Dr. Santomero deferred $122,207 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. As of December 31, 2009, the value of Dr. Santomero’s account under that plan was $203,951.

Independent Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

    

Total Compensation from the
Columbia Funds Complex
Paid to Independent Trustees
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a

Independent Trustees

  

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

   $295,000

William P. Carmichael

   $357,500

Minor M. Shaw

   $287,500

R. Glenn Hilliard

   $290,000

William A. Hawkins

   $297,500

John J. Nagorniak

   $250,000

Interested Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

    

Total Compensation from the
Columbia Funds Complex
Paid to Interested Trustee
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a

Interested Trustees

  

Anthony M. Santomero

   $265,000

Columbia Funds Deferred Compensation Plan

Under the terms of the Deferred Fee Agreement (the Deferred Compensation Plan), each eligible Trustee may elect, on an annual basis, to defer receipt of all or a portion of compensation payable to him or her for

 

140


Table of Contents

service as Trustee for that calendar year. Fees deferred by a Trustee are credited to a book reserve account (the Deferral Account) established by the Columbia Funds, the value of which is derived from the rate of return of one or more Columbia Funds selected by the Trustee (with accruals to the Deferral Account beginning at such time as a Trustee’s fund elections having been established, and fees for service having been paid into such account, and terminating at such time as when proceeds become payable to such Trustee under the Deferred Compensation Plan). Trustees may change their fund elections only in accordance with the provisions of the Deferred Compensation Plan.

Distributions from a Trustee’s Deferral Account will be paid by check, either in a lump sum or in annual installments. Payments made in annual installments are disbursed over a period of up to ten years, following such time as a Trustee may qualify to receive such payments. If a deferring Trustee dies prior to or after the commencement of the disbursement of amounts accrued in his/her Deferral Account, the balance of the account will be distributed to his/her designated beneficiary either in lump sum or in annual payments as established by such Trustee himself/herself, his/her beneficiary or his/her estate. Amounts payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan are not funded or secured in any way, and each deferring Trustee has the status of an unsecured creditor of the Columbia Fund(s) selected by such Trustee.

Beneficial Equity Ownership

As of the date of this SAI, the Trustees and Officers of the Trust, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of each class of shares of each Fund. The table below shows, for each Trustee, the amount of Fund equity securities beneficially owned by the Trustee and the aggregate value of all investments in equity securities of the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustees, including notional amounts through the Deferred Compensation Plan, stated as one of the following ranges: A = $0; B = $1-$10,000; C = $10,001-$50,000; D = $50,001-$100,000; and E = over $100,000.

Independent Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.
   William P.
Carmichael
   Minor M.
Shaw
   R. Glenn
Hilliard
   William A.
Hawkins
   John J.
Nagorniak

Asset Allocation Fund II

   A    A    A    A    A    A

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Convertible Securities Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Global Value Fund

   C    A    A    A    A    A

High Income Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

International Value Fund

   A    E    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Core Fund

   C    A    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Index Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Large Cap Value Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   B    D    A    A    A    A

Marsico Global Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

 

141


Table of Contents

Fund

   Edward J.
Boudreau, Jr.
   William P.
Carmichael
   Minor M.
Shaw
   R. Glenn
Hilliard
   William A.
Hawkins
   John J.
Nagorniak

Marsico Growth Fund

   A    D    A    A    A    A

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Mid Cap Index Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Mid Cap Value Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Overseas Value Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Short Term Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   B    D    A    A    A    A

Small Cap Index Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Small Cap Value Fund II

   B    A    A    A    A    A

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Total Return Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A    A    A    A    A    A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

   E    E    E    E    A    E

Interested Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   Anthony M.
Santomero

Asset Allocation Fund II

   A

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Convertible Securities Fund

   A

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   A

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Global Value Fund

   A

High Income Fund

   A

International Value Fund

   A

Large Cap Core Fund

   A

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   A

Large Cap Index Fund

   A

Large Cap Value Fund

   A

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   A

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   A

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   A

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   A

 

142


Table of Contents

Fund

   Anthony M.
Santomero

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   A

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   A

Marsico Global Fund

   A

Marsico Growth Fund

   A

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   A

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   A

Mid Cap Index Fund

   A

Mid Cap Value Fund

   A

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

   A

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   A

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Overseas Value Fund

   A

Short Term Bond Fund

   A

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   A

Small Cap Index Fund

   A

Small Cap Value Fund II

   A

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Total Return Bond Fund

   A

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   A

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

   E

The Officers

The following table provides basic information about the Officers of the Trust as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period.

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

J. Kevin Connaughton

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   President (Principal Executive Officer)    2009   

Senior Vice President and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President, Columbia Funds, since 2009, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010 (previously Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Columbia

Funds, from June 2008 to January 2009, Treasurer, Columbia Funds, from October 2003 to May 2008, and senior officer of various other affiliated funds since 2000); Managing Director, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from December 2004 to April 2010.

 

143


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Michael G. Clarke

(Born 1969)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)    2009    Vice President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Managing Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from September 2004 to April 2010; senior officer of Columbia Funds and affiliated funds since 2002.

Scott R. Plummer

(Born 1959)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer    2010    Chief Legal Officer and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since June 2005; Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, from 2005 to April 2010, and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance from 2004 to 2005); Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, RiverSource Funds, since December 2006; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since May 2010.

Linda J. Wondrack

(Born 1964)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer    2007    Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Funds, since 2007, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, from June 2005 to April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer of MFS Investment Management (investment management) from August 2004 to May 2005.

 

144


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

William F. Truscott

(Born 1960)

53600 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Senior Vice President    2010    Chairman of the Board, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to April 2010); Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President, Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer from 2005 to April 2010, and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to 2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer from 2008 to April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006.

Colin Moore

(Born 1958)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Senior Vice President    2010    Director and Chief Investment Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2002 to 2007.

Michael A. Jones

(Born 1959)

100 Federal Street

Boston, MA 02110

   Senior Vice President    2010    Director and President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from November 2006 to April 2010; previously, co-president and senior managing director at Robeco Investment Management.

 

145


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Amy Johnson

(Born 1965)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Senior Vice President    2010    Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of the Adviser, since May 2010; Chief Administrative Officer, the Adviser from 2009 until May 2010; Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, the Adviser, 2006-2009; Vice President – Operations and Compliance, the Adviser, 2004-2006; Director of Product Development – Mutual Funds, Ameriprise Financial, 2001-2004.

Joseph F. DiMaria

(Born 1968)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Treasurer and Chief Accounting Officer    2008    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2006 to April 2010; Head of Tax/Compliance and Assistant Treasurer, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from November 2004 to December 2005.

Marybeth Pilat

(Born 1968)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Deputy Treasurer    2010    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Vice President, Investment Operations, Bank of America, from October 2008 to April 2010; Finance Manager, Boston Children’s Hospital from August 2008 to October 2008; Director, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from May 2007 to July 2008; Vice President, Mutual Fund Valuation, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from January 2006 to May 2007; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2005 to January 2006.

 

146


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Julian Quero

(Born 1967)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Deputy Treasurer    2008    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from August 2008 to April 2010; Senior Tax Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from August 2006 to July 2008; Senior Compliance Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from April 2002 to August 2006.

Stephen T. Welsh

(Born 1957)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Vice President    2006    President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Services, Inc. from July 2004 to April 2010; Managing Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from August 2007 to April 2010.

Kathryn Thompson

(Born 1967)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Assistant Treasurer    2006    Director, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight and Treasury of the Adviser, since May 2010; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight of the Previous Adviser from December 2004 to April 2010; Vice President, State Street Corporation (financial services) prior to December 2004.

Paul B. Goucher

(Born 1968)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel of Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel from November 2008 to January 2010); Director, Managing Director and General Counsel of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated (Seligman) from July 2008 to November 2008 and Managing Director and Associate General Counsel of Seligman from January 2005 to July 2008.

Ryan C. Larrenaga

(Born 1970)

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

   Assistant Secretary    2005    Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since May 2010; Assistant General Counsel, Bank of America from March 2005 to April 2010; Associate, Ropes & Gray LLP (law firm) from 1998 to February 2005.

 

147


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth and Address

  

Position
with

the Trust

   Year First
Elected or
Appointed to
Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)

During the Past Five Years

Christopher O. Petersen

(Born 1970)

5228 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel or Counsel from April 2004 to January 2010); Assistant Secretary of RiverSource Funds since January 2007.

 

148


Table of Contents

 

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

Subject to policies established by the Board, the Adviser (or the investment subadviser(s) who make the day-to-day investment decisions for a Fund, as applicable) is responsible for decisions to buy and sell securities for each Fund, for the selection of broker/dealers, for the execution of a Fund’s securities transactions and for the allocation of brokerage commissions in connection with such transactions. The Adviser’s primary consideration in effecting a security transaction is to obtain the best net price and the most favorable execution of the order. Purchases and sales of securities on a securities exchange are effected through brokers who charge negotiated commissions for their services. Orders may be directed to any broker to the extent and in the manner permitted by applicable law.

In the over-the-counter market, securities generally are traded on a “net” basis with dealers acting as principals for their own accounts without stated commissions, although the price of a security usually includes a profit to the dealer. In underwritten offerings, securities are bought at a fixed price that includes an amount of compensation to the underwriter, generally referred to as the underwriter’s “concession” or “discount.” On occasion, certain money market instruments may be bought directly from an issuer, in which case no commissions or discounts are paid.

In placing orders for portfolio securities of the Funds, the Adviser gives primary consideration to obtaining the best net prices and most favorable execution. This means that the Adviser will seek to execute each transaction at a price and commission, if any, which provides the most favorable total cost or proceeds reasonably attainable in the circumstances. In seeking such execution, the Adviser will use its best judgment in evaluating the terms of a transaction, and will give consideration to various relevant factors, including, without limitation, the size and type of the transaction, the nature and character of the market for the security, the confidentiality, speed and certainty of effective execution required for the transaction, the general execution and operational capabilities of the broker/dealer, the reputation, reliability, experience and financial condition of the broker/dealer, the value and quality of the services rendered by the broker/dealer in this instance and other transactions and the reasonableness of the spread or commission, if any. Research services received from broker/dealers supplement the Adviser’s own research and may include the following types of information: statistical and background information on industry groups and individual companies; forecasts and interpretations with respect to U.S. and foreign economies, securities, markets, specific industry groups and individual companies; information on political developments; Fund management strategies; performance information on securities and information concerning prices of securities; and information supplied by specialized services to the Adviser and to the Board with respect to the performance, investment activities and fees and expenses of other mutual funds. Such information may be communicated electronically, orally or in written form. Research services also may include the arranging of meetings with management of companies and the provision of access to consultants who supply research information.

The outside research is useful to the Adviser since, in certain instances, the broker/dealers utilized by the Adviser may follow a different universe of securities issuers and other matters than those that the Adviser’s staff can follow. In addition, this research provides the Adviser with a different perspective on financial markets, even if the securities research obtained relates to issues followed by the Adviser. Research services that are provided to the Adviser by broker/dealers are available for the benefit of all accounts managed or advised by the Adviser. In some cases, the research services are available only from the broker/dealer providing such services. In other cases, the research services may be obtainable from alternative sources. The Adviser is of the opinion that because the broker/dealer research supplements rather than replaces the Adviser’s own research, the receipt of such research does not tend to decrease the Adviser’s expenses, but tends to improve the quality of its investment advice. However, to the extent that the Adviser would have bought any such research services had such services not been provided by broker/dealers, the expenses of such services to the Adviser could be considered to have been reduced accordingly. Certain research services furnished by broker/dealers may be useful to the clients of

 

149


Table of Contents

the Adviser other than the Funds. Conversely, any research services received by the Adviser through the placement of transactions of other clients may be of value to the Adviser in fulfilling its obligations to the Funds. The Adviser is of the opinion that this material is beneficial in supplementing its research and analysis; and, therefore, it may benefit the Trust by improving the quality of the Adviser’s investment advice. The advisory fees paid by the Trust are not reduced because the Adviser receives such services.

Under Section 28(e) of the 1934 Act, the Adviser shall not be “deemed to have acted unlawfully or to have breached its fiduciary duty” solely because under certain circumstances it has caused the account to pay a higher commission than the lowest available. To obtain the benefit of Section 28(e), the Adviser must make a good faith determination that the commissions paid are “reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage and research services provided by such member, broker, or dealer, viewed in terms of either that particular transaction or his overall responsibilities with respect to the accounts as to which he exercises investment discretion.” Accordingly, the price to a Funds in any transaction may be less favorable than that available from another broker/dealer if the difference is reasonably justified by other aspects of the portfolio execution services offered. Some broker/dealers may indicate that the provision of research services is dependent upon the generation of certain specified levels of commissions and underwriting concessions by the Adviser’s clients, including the Funds.

Commission rates are established pursuant to negotiations with broker/dealers based on the quality and quantity of execution services provided by broker/dealers in light of generally prevailing rates. On exchanges on which commissions are negotiated, the cost of transactions may vary among different broker/dealers. Transactions on foreign stock exchanges involve payment of brokerage commissions that generally are fixed. Transactions in both foreign and domestic over-the-counter markets generally are principal transactions with dealers, and the costs of such transactions involve dealer spreads rather than brokerage commissions. With respect to over-the-counter transactions, the Adviser, where possible, will deal directly with dealers who make a market in the securities involved, except in those circumstances in which better prices and execution are available elsewhere.

In certain instances there may be securities that are suitable for a Fund as well as for one or more of the other clients of the Adviser. Investment decisions for the Funds and for the Adviser’s other clients are made with the goal of achieving their respective investment objectives. A particular security may be bought or sold for only one client even though it may be held by, or bought or sold for, other clients. Likewise, a particular security may be bought for one or more clients when one or more other clients are selling that same security. Some simultaneous transactions are inevitable when a number of accounts receive investment advice from the same investment adviser, particularly when the same security is suitable for the investment objectives of more than one client. When two or more clients are engaged simultaneously in the purchase or sale of the same security, the securities are allocated among clients in a manner believed to be equitable to each. In some cases, this policy could have a detrimental effect on the price or volume of the security in a particular transaction that may affect the Funds.

The Funds may participate, if and when practicable, in bidding for the purchase of portfolio securities directly from an issuer in order to take advantage of the lower purchase price available to members of a bidding group. A Fund will engage in this practice, however, only when the Adviser, in its sole discretion, believes such practice to be otherwise in such Fund’s interests.

The Trust will not execute portfolio transactions through, or buy or sell portfolio securities from or to, the Distributor, the Adviser, the Administrator or their affiliates acting as principal (including repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements), except to the extent permitted by applicable law, regulation or order. However, the Adviser is authorized to allocate buy and sell orders for portfolio securities to certain broker/dealers and financial institutions, including, in the case of agency transactions, broker/dealers and financial institutions that are affiliated with Ameriprise Financial. To the extent that a Fund executes any securities trades with an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial, such Fund does so in conformity with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act and the procedures that such Fund has adopted pursuant to the rule. In this regard, for each transaction, the Board will determine

 

150


Table of Contents

that: (i) the transaction resulted in prices for and execution of securities transactions at least as favorable to the particular Fund as those likely to be derived from a non-affiliated qualified broker/dealer; (ii) the affiliated broker/dealer charged the Fund commission rates consistent with those charged by the affiliated broker/dealer in similar transactions to clients comparable to the Fund and that are not affiliated with the broker/dealer in question; and (iii) the fees, commissions or other remuneration paid by the Fund did not exceed 2% of the sales price of the securities if the sale was effected in connection with a secondary distribution, or 1% of the purchase or sale price of such securities if effected in other than a secondary distribution.

Certain affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may have deposit, loan or commercial banking relationships with the corporate users of facilities financed by industrial development revenue bonds or private activity bonds bought by certain of the Columbia Funds. Ameriprise Financial or certain of its affiliates may serve as trustee, custodian, tender agent, guarantor, placement agent, underwriter, or in some other capacity, with respect to certain issues of securities. Under certain circumstances, a Fund may buy securities from a member of an underwriting syndicate in which an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial is a member. The Trust has adopted procedures pursuant to Rule 10f-3 under the 1940 Act, and intends to comply with the requirements of Rule 10f-3, in connection with any purchases of municipal securities that may be subject to Rule 10f-3.

Given the breadth of the Adviser’s investment management activities, investment decisions for the Funds are not always made independently from those for other funds, or other investment companies and accounts advised or managed by the Adviser. When a purchase or sale of the same security is made at substantially the same time on behalf of one or more of the Columbia Funds and another investment portfolio, investment company or account, the transaction will be averaged as to price and available investments allocated as to amount in a manner which the Adviser believes to be equitable to the Funds and such other funds, investment portfolio, investment company or account. In some instances, this investment procedure may adversely affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the position obtained or sold by the Fund. To the extent permitted by law, the Adviser may aggregate the securities to be sold or bought for the Funds with those to be sold or bought for other funds, investment portfolios, investment companies, or accounts in executing transactions.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about these and other conflicts of interest.

Brokerage Commissions

The following charts reflect the amounts of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recently completed fiscal periods/years. In certain instances, the Funds may pay brokerage commissions to broker/dealers that are affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. As indicated above, all such transactions involving the payment of brokerage commissions to affiliates are done in compliance with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act.

Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds

The following charts reflect the aggregate amount of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recently completed fiscal periods/years. Differences, year to year, in the amount of brokerage commissions paid by a Fund were primarily the result of increased market volatility as well as shareholder purchase and redemption activity in the Fund.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Convertible Securities Fund

   $ 78,360       $ 322,359       $ 284,499   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   $ 252,593       $ 1,214,329       $ 903,415   

Large Cap Index Fund

   $ 79,256       $ 57,287       $ 36,653   

Large Cap Value Fund

   $ 3,143,773       $ 3,621,587       $ 3,846,915   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $ 14,472,692       $ 18,909,158       $ 17,682,363   

 

151


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
    Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
    Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $ 6,634,701      $ 5,535,587      $ 3,076,353   

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $ 4,607,371      $ 2,963,749      $ 2,042,309   

Global Value Fund

   $ 43,086      $ 97,403.51      $ 336,900   

Marsico Global Fund1

   $ 19,741      $ 15,550        N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $ 4,199,116      $ 7,094,625      $ 8,847,436   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   $ 126,059      $ 131,394      $ 146,945   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $ 2,712,557   $ 3,912,632 **    $ 4,860,579 *** 

Overseas Value Fund2

   $ 16,847      $ 28,497        N/A   

Small Cap Index Fund

   $ 123,678      $ 188,373      $ 172,836   

 

* This amount includes $220,976 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that was subadvised by Causeway and $2,491,581 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that is subadvised by Marsico.
** This amount includes $829,079 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that was subadvised by Causeway and $3,083,553 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that is sub-advised by Marsico.
***

This amount includes $1,112, 239 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that was subadvised by Causeway and $3,748,340 in commissions paid by the portion of the Fund that is sub-advised by Marsico.

1

Marsico Global Fund commenced operations in April 2008 and therefore paid no brokerage commissions prior to that date.

2

Overseas Value Fund commenced operations on March 31, 2008 and therefore paid no brokerage commissions prior to that date.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007
 

International Value Fund*

   $ 962,909       $ 1,020,816       $ 3,079,182       $ 3,022,497   

Large Cap Core Fund

   $ 3,517,838       $ 3,504,058       $ 2,410,933       $ 3,338,986   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $ 6,633,291       $ 7,461,288       $ 7,365,073       $ 3,408,940   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $ 8,957,276       $ 11,114,481       $ 5,108,886       $ 3,906,181   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 1,469,836       $ 1,413,250       $ 2,688,711       $ 2,144,191   

 

* Because the Feeder Fund’s brokerage commissions are paid at the Master Portfolio level, amounts shown are for the Fund’s Master Portfolio.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $ 21,870       $ 41,585       $ 28,943   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,099         —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

   $ 961       $ 12,273       $ 1,862   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 472         —     

High Income Fund

   $ 3,715       $ 36,672       $ 75,531   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   $ 8,650         —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   $ 5,730         —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   $ 2,180         —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     —           —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 875         —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     —           —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

     —           —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,619         —     

Short Term Bond Fund

   $ 34,869       $ 10,309       $ 8,123   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,486         —     

Total Return Bond Fund

   $ 85,184       $ 89,362       $ 57,337   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —         $ 1,261         —     

 

152


Table of Contents

 

Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds to Certain Broker/Dealers

The Funds paid brokerage commissions to certain broker/dealers for the three most recently completed fiscal periods/years, as indicated in the following table:

 

         Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid  

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*   Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 29, 2008
 

Global Value Fund

   BAS     —         $ 2,907       $ 3,722   
   MLPF&S   $ 2,509         —           N/A   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   Banc of America
Securities LLC

(BAS)

    —           —           —     
   Merrill Lynch,
Pierce, Fenner &
Smith
Incorporated

(MLPF&S)

  $ 413,221       $ 12,001         N/A   

Marsico Global Value Fund

   BAS     —           —           N/A   
   MLPF&S   $ 839         —           N/A   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   BAS     —           —           N/A   
   MLPF&S   $ 184,099       $ 24,106         N/A   

Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund (Causeway**

and Marsico)

   BAS     —           —           N/A   

Causeway**

   MLPF&S   $ 33,848       $ 11,737         N/A   

Marsico

   MLPF&S   $ 106,469       $ 13,484         N/A   

 

          Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid  

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*    Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
February 28, 2009
     Fiscal Period Ended
February 29, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2007
 

International Value Fund

   BAS      —           —         $ 5,021         N/A   
   MLPF&S    $ 12,546       $ 40,508         N/A         N/A   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   BAS      —           —           —           —     
   MLPF&S    $ 70,447       $ 713         N/A         N/A   

Marsico Growth Fund

   BAS      —           —           —           —     
   MLPF&S    $ 148,003       $ 16,336         N/A         N/A   

 

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*      Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Brokerage Commissions Paid to the
Certain Broker/Dealers During the
Most Recent Fiscal Year
    Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Dollar Amount of Transactions
Involving the Payment of
Commissions Effected Through the
Broker/Dealer During the Most
Recent Fiscal Year
 

Marsico 21st Century Fund

     MLPF&S         2.86     2.68

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

     MLPF&S         1.06     1.97

 

153


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer*      Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Brokerage Commissions Paid to the
Certain Broker/Dealers During the
Most Recent Fiscal Year
    Percentage of the Fund’s Aggregate
Dollar Amount of Transactions
Involving the Payment of
Commissions Effected Through the
Broker/Dealer During the Most
Recent Fiscal Year
 

Marsico Growth Fund

     MLPF&S         1.65     2.42

Global Value Fund

     MLPF&S         1.5     5.8

Marsico Global Value Fund

     MLPF&S         4.25     3.59

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

     MLPF&S         4.38     5.55

Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

       

Causeway**

     MLPF&S         15     28

Marsico

     MLPF&S         4.27     5.37

International Value Fund

     MLPF&S         1.3     1.3

 

* Prior to May 1, 2010, BAS and MLPF&S (as of January 1, 2009) and other broker-dealers affiliated with BANA were affiliated broker/dealers of the Fund by virtue of being under common control with the Previous Adviser. The affiliation created by this relationship ended on May 1, 2010, when the investment advisory agreement with the Previous Adviser was terminated and the Fund entered into a new investment management services agreement with the Adviser. However, BANA, on behalf of its fiduciary accounts, continues to have investments in certain of the Columbia Funds. The amounts shown include any brokerage commissions paid to BAS and MLPF&S after May 1, 2010.
** Causeway served as co-investment subadviser to approximately half of the assets of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund until July 8, 2009. At that time, the Previous Adviser assumed primary investment management responsibility for that portion of Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund previously subadvised by Causeway.

Directed Brokerage

The Funds or the Adviser, through an agreement or understanding with a broker/dealer, or otherwise through an internal allocation procedure, may direct, subject to applicable legal requirements, the Funds’ brokerage transactions to a broker/dealer because of the research services it provides the Funds or the Adviser.

During each Fund’s last fiscal year, the Funds directed certain brokerage transactions and paid related commissions in the amounts as follows:

 

Fund

   Amount of Transactions      Related Commissions  

For Funds with fiscal year ended February 28, 2010

     

Convertible Securities Fund

   $ 84,141,442       $ 19,218   

Global Value Fund

     —           —     

International Value Fund

     —           —     

Large Cap Core Fund

   $ 3,437,201,420       $ 597,376   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

     —           —     

Large Cap Index Fund

     —           —     

Large Cap Value Fund

   $ 2,852,218,744       $ 356,068   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   $ 1,653,516,816       $ 2,716,976   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   $ 874,643,755       $ 1,240,638   

Marsico Global Fund

   $ 2,641,551       $ 4,576   

Marsico Growth Fund

   $ 1,072,612,866       $ 1,670,277   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   $ 1,148,257,498       $ 2,071,350   

Mid Cap Index Fund

     —           —     

Mid Cap Value Fund

   $ 4,260,260,243       $ 407,393   

 

154


Table of Contents

Fund

   Amount of Transactions      Related Commissions  

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   $ 730,003,570       $ 1,447,999   

Overseas Value Fund

   $ 8,723,978       $ 2,053   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   $ 680,363,344       $ 64,147   

Small Cap Index Fund

     —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund II

   $ 1,661,955,281       $ 199,929   

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

     

Asset Allocation Fund II

   $ 764,628       $ 604   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     —           —     

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

High Income Fund

   $ 81,665       $ 464   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     —           —     

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     —           —     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     —           —     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     —           —     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     —           —     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

     —           —     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Short Term Bond Fund

     —           —     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Total Return Bond Fund

     —           —     

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     —           —     

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

In certain cases, the Funds, as part of their principal investment strategies, or otherwise as a permissible investment, will invest in the common stock or debt obligations of the regular broker/dealers that the Adviser uses to transact brokerage for the Funds.

As of each Fund’s fiscal year end, the Funds owned securities of their “regular brokers or dealers” or their parents, as defined in Rule 10b-1 under the 1940 Act, as shown in the table below:

Investments in Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

 

Fund

   Broker/Dealer      Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended February 28, 2010

     

Convertible Securities Fund

     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 4,440,770   
     Goldman Sachs & Co.       $ 9,896,282   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 10,683,096   
     Deutsche Bank AG       $ 18,036,980   

Global Value Fund

     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 790,054   

International Value Fund

     None       $ 0   

 

155


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer    Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

Large Cap Core Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 4,523,454   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 35,273,686   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 27,955,380   
   State Street Corp.    $ 2,792,055   

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 5,206,455   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 7,470,660   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 284,618   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 4,344,860   

Large Cap Index Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 21,179,640   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 10,092,695   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 43,572,205   
   State Street Corp.    $ 5,854,872   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 17,466,643   
   Bank of New York Mellon Corp.    $ 9,049,225   

Large Cap Value Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 71,514,490   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 37,947,188   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 88,368,255   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 24,164,391   

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 209,491,338   
   State Street Corp.    $ 76,167,719   
   Jefferies Group, Inc.    $ 102,963,894   

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 112,953,650   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 101,678,956   

Marsico Global Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 262,858   

Marsico Growth Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 136,367,376   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 119,551,041   

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 36,296,625   

Mid Cap Index Fund

   Jefferies Group, Inc.    $ 6,256,224   

Mid Cap Value Fund

   None    $ 0   

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 11,847,972   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 22,572,834   

Overseas Value Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 144,656   

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   None    $ 0   

Small Cap Index Fund

   None    $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund II

   None    $ 0   

 

156


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer      Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

     

Asset Allocation Fund II

     Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.       $ 714,439   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 3,467,919   
     Goldman Sachs & Co.       $ 644,830   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 710,140   
     Barclays Capital       $ 193,601   
     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 418,309   
     Wachovia Corp.       $ 646,632   
     UBS Warburg LLC       $ 326,481   

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

Corporate Bond Portfolio

     Barclays Capital       $ 138,762   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 86,304   
     Wells Fargo & Co.       $ 135,807   

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

High Income Fund

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

Masters International Equity Portfolio

     None       $ 0   

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 151,287   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 653,143   
     Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.       $ 1,294,949   
     Wells Fargo & Co.       $ 1,921,226   
     UBS Warburg LLC       $ 1,383,094   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 421,470   

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

Short Term Bond Fund

     Barclays Capital       $ 15,359,481   
     CS First Boston Corp.       $ 78,017,877   
     Goldman Sachs & Co.       $ 18,335,446   
     JPMorgan Chase & Co.       $ 62,171,265   
     Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.       $ 10,283,062   
     Citigroup, Inc.       $ 17,660,333   
     Wells Fargo & Co.       $ 17,312,165   
     UBS Warburg LLC       $ 28,990,178   

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

     None       $ 0   

 

157


Table of Contents

Fund

   Broker/Dealer    Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

Total Return Bond Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 3,555,138   
   Wells Fargo & Co.    $ 51,378,326   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 20,592,570   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 40,962,258   
   UBS Warburg LLC    $ 20,553,415   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 13,233,784   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 22,018,435   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 15,153,171   

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   None    $ 0   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

The Funds, along with the Transfer Agent and/or the Distributor and the Adviser, may pay significant amounts to financial intermediaries (as defined below), including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for providing the types of services that would typically be provided directly by a mutual fund’s transfer agent. The level of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. A number of factors may be considered in determining payments to a financial intermediary, including, without limitation, the nature of the services provided to shareholders or retirement plan participants that invest in the Funds through retirement plans. These services may include sub-accounting, sub-transfer agency or similar recordkeeping services, shareholder or participant reporting, shareholder or participant transaction processing, and/or the provision of call center support (additional shareholder services). These payments for shareholder servicing support with respect to the Columbia Funds vary by financial intermediary but generally are not expected, with certain limited exceptions, to exceed 0.40% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan, and 0.45% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that do not pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan. The Board has authorized each Fund to pay up to 0.15% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares. Such payments will be made by a Fund to the Transfer Agent who will in turn make payments to the financial intermediary for the provision of such additional shareholder services. The Funds’ Transfer Agent, Distributor or their affiliates will pay, from its or their own resources, amounts in excess of the amount paid by the Funds to financial intermediaries in connection with the provision of these additional shareholder services and other services.

For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment advisor, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Funds also may make additional payments to financial intermediaries that charge networking fees for certain services provided in connection with the maintenance of shareholder accounts through the NSCC.

In addition, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may make lump sum payments to selected financial intermediaries receiving shareholder servicing payments in reimbursement of printing costs for literature for participants, account maintenance fees or fees for establishment of the Funds on the financial intermediary’s system or other similar services.

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates had agreed to make shareholder servicing payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

 

158


Table of Contents

 

Recipients of Shareholder Servicing Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

Acclaim Benefits, Inc.

   

A.G. Edwards

   

Alerus Retirement Solutions

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Benefit Plan Administrators

   

Bisys Retirement Services

   

Charles Schwab & Co.

   

Charles Schwab Trust Co.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

CitiStreet LLC

   

City National Bank

   

Compensation & Capital Administrative Services, Inc.

   

CPI Qualified Plan Consultants

   

Daily Access Concepts, Inc.

   

Digital Retirement Solutions

   

Dreyfus

   

Edward D. Jones & Co., L.P.

   

E*Trade Group, Inc.

   

ExpertPlan

   

Fidelity Investments Institutional Operations Co.

   

First Clearing LLC

   

Genworth Financial

   

GPC Securities, Inc.

   

Guardian Life Insurance Company

   

GWFS Equities, Inc.

   

Hartford Life Insurance Company

   

Hewitt Associates LLC

   

ICMA Retirement Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Company

   

ING Institutional Plan Services, LLP

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company (USA)

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company of New York

   

JP Morgan Retirement Plan Services LLC

   

Lincoln Financial Group

   

LPL Financial Corporation

   

Marshall & Illsley Trust Company

   

Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company

   

Matrix Settlement & Clearance Services

   

Mercer HR Services, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Mid Atlantic Capital Corporation

   

Morgan Keegan & Co., Inc.

   

Morgan Stanley & Co., Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Investor Services Corp.

   

Newport Retirement Services, Inc.

   

New York State Deferred Compensation Plan

   

NYLife Distributors LLC

   

PNC Advisors

   

Princeton Retirement Group

   

Principal Life Insurance Company

   

Prudential Insurance Company of America

   

Prudential Retirement Insurance & Annuity Co.

   

Reliance Trust Company

   

Robert W. Baird & Co., Inc.

   

Royal Alliance Associates, Inc.

   

Standard Retirement Services, Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Clearing Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Trust Company

   

Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association of America

   

The 401k Company

   

T. Rowe Price Group, Inc.

   

The Vanguard Group, Inc.

   

Unified Trust Company, N.A.

   

UPromise Investments, Inc.

   

VALIC Retirement Services

   

Wachovia Bank, N.A.

   

Wachovia Securities, LLC

   

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management, LLC

   

Wilmington Trust Corporation

   

Wilmington Trust Retirement & Institutional Services Company


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

 

159


Table of Contents

 

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

Financial intermediaries may receive different commissions, sales charge reallowances and other payments with respect to sales of different classes of shares of the Funds. These other payments may include servicing payments to retirement plan administrators and other institutions at rates up to those described above under Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices — Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment adviser, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may pay additional compensation to selected financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, under the categories described below. These categories are not mutually exclusive, and a single financial intermediary may receive payments under all categories. A financial intermediary also may receive payments described above in Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices — Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. These payments may create an incentive for a financial intermediary or its representatives to recommend or offer shares of a Fund to its customers. The amount of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. In determining the amount of payments to be made, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may consider a number of factors, including, without limitation, asset mix and length of relationship with the financial intermediary, the size of the customer/shareholder base of the financial intermediary, the manner in which customers of the financial intermediary make investments in the Funds, the nature and scope of marketing support or services provided by the financial intermediary (as described more fully below) and the costs incurred by the financial intermediary in connection with maintaining the infrastructure necessary or desirable to support investments in the Funds.

These additional payments by the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates are made pursuant to agreements between the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates and financial intermediaries, and do not change the price paid by investors for the purchase of a share, the amount a Fund will receive as proceeds from such sales or the distribution fees and expenses paid by the Fund as shown under the heading Fees and Expenses of the Fund/Portfolio in the Fund’s prospectuses.

Marketing Support Payments

The Distributor and the Adviser may make payments, from their own resources, to certain financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for marketing support services relating to the Columbia Funds, including, but not limited to, business planning assistance, educating financial intermediary personnel about the Funds and shareholder financial planning needs, placement on the financial intermediary’s preferred or recommended fund list or otherwise identifying the Funds as being part of a complex to be accorded a higher degree of marketing support than complexes not making such payments, access to sales meetings, sales representatives and management representatives of the financial intermediary, client servicing and systems infrastructure support. These payments are generally based upon one or more of the following factors: average net assets of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, gross sales of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, reimbursement of ticket charges (fees that a financial intermediary firm charges its representatives for effecting transactions in fund shares) or a negotiated lump sum payment.

While the financial arrangements may vary for each financial intermediary, the marketing support payments to each financial intermediary generally are expected to be between 0.05% and 0.50% on an annual basis for payments based on average net assets of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary, and between 0.05% and 0.25% on an annual basis for firms receiving a payment based on gross sales of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary. The Distributor and affiliates may make payments in materially larger amounts or on a basis materially different from those described above when dealing with certain financial intermediaries. Such increased payments may enable the financial intermediaries to offset credits that they may provide to their customers.

 

160


Table of Contents

 

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or the Adviser had agreed to make marketing support payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

Recipients of Marketing Support Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

AIG Advisor Group

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

AXA Advisors, LLC

   

Banc of America Investment Services, Inc.

   

Banc of America Securities LLC

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Bank of New York

   

Citibank, N.A.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

Commonwealth Financial Network

   

Custodial Trust Company

   

Fidelity Brokerage Services, Inc.

   

Genworth Financial, Inc.

   

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

   

GunAllen Financial, Inc.

   

Harris Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Co.

   

J.J.B. Hilliard, W.L. Lyons, Inc.

   

J.P. Morgan Clearing Corp.

   

Liberty Life Insurance Co.

   

Lincoln Financial Advisors Corp.

   

Linsco/Private Ledger Corp.

   

Mellon Financial Markets, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Financial Services LLC

   

Pershing LLC

   

Prudential Investment Management Services, LLC

   

Raymond James & Associates, Inc.

   

Raymond James Financial Services, Inc.

   

SEI Investments Inc.

   

State Street Global Markets, LLC

   

Transamerica Corporation

   

UBS Financial Services Inc.

   

US Bank National Association

   

Wachovia Securities LLC

   

Webster Investment Services, Inc.

   

Wells Fargo Corporate Trust Services

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management LLC

   

Wells Fargo Investments, LLC


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or the Adviser may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

Other Payments

From time to time, the Distributor, from its own resources, may provide additional compensation to certain financial intermediaries that sell or arrange for the sale of shares of the Funds to the extent not prohibited by laws or the rules of any self-regulatory agency, such as the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA). Such compensation provided by the Distributor may include financial assistance to financial intermediaries that enable the Distributor to participate in and/or present at financial intermediary-sponsored conferences or seminars, sales or training programs for invited registered representatives and other financial intermediary employees, financial intermediary entertainment and other financial intermediary-sponsored events, and travel expenses, including lodging incurred by registered representatives and other employees in connection with prospecting, retention and due diligence trips. The Distributor makes payments for entertainment events it deems appropriate, subject to the Distributor’s internal guidelines and applicable law. These payments may vary depending upon the nature of the event.

Your financial intermediary may charge you fees or commissions in addition to those disclosed in this SAI. You should consult with your financial intermediary and review carefully any disclosure your financial intermediary provides regarding its services and compensation. Depending on the financial arrangement in place

 

161


Table of Contents

at any particular time, a financial intermediary and its financial consultants may have a financial incentive for recommending a particular fund or a particular share class over other funds or share classes. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information.

 

162


Table of Contents

 

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

Description of the Trust’s Shares

The Funds offer shares in the classes shown in the table below. Subject to certain limited exceptions discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses, a Fund may no longer be accepting new investments from current shareholders or prospective investors. Class B shares of the Funds are closed to new investments, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares. Additional Class B shares of the Funds will be issued only in connection with (i) reinvestment of dividends and/or capital gain distributions in Class B shares of each Fund by the Fund’s existing Class B shareholders and (ii) exchanges by shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Columbia Fund may exchange those shares for Class B shares of a Fund. The Funds, however, may at any time and without notice, offer any of these classes to the general public for investment.

The Trust’s Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust (Declaration of Trust) permits it to issue an unlimited number of full and fractional shares of beneficial interest of each Fund, without par value, and to divide or combine the shares of any series into a greater or lesser number of shares of that Fund without thereby changing the proportionate beneficial interests in that Fund and to divide such shares into classes. Each share of a class of a Fund represents an equal proportional interest in that Fund with each other share in the same class and is entitled to such distributions out of the income earned on the assets belonging to that Fund as are declared in the discretion of the Board. However, different share classes of a Fund pay different distribution amounts because each share class has different expenses. Each time a distribution is made, the net asset value per share of the share class is reduced by the amount of the distribution.

Share Classes Offered by the Funds

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares1
     Class C
Shares
     Class I
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class R4
Shares
     Shares      Class W
Shares
     Class  Y
Shares3
     Class Z
Shares
 

Asset Allocation Fund II

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

Convertible Securities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü                        ü     

Corporate Bond Portfolio

                     ü              

Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

Global Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

High Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

International Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü                     ü     

Large Cap Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü                  ü            ü     

Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

   ü               ü         ü                  ü         ü     

Large Cap Index Fund

   ü         ü                              ü     

Large Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü               ü         ü         ü     

LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                     ü     

 

163


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares1
     Class C
Shares
     Class I
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class R4
Shares
    Shares      Class W
Shares
     Class  Y
Shares3
     Class Z
Shares
 

LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Marsico 21st Century Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

Marsico Focused Equities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü                       ü     

Marsico Global Fund

   ü            ü            ü                    ü     

Marsico Growth Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü              ü            ü     

Marsico International Opportunities Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü                    ü     

Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Masters International Equity Portfolio

   ü         ü         ü            ü                    ü     

Mid Cap Index Fund

   ü               ü                       ü     

Mid Cap Value Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü  2         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

                    ü              

Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü  2         ü            ü     

North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Overseas Value Fund

   ü            ü            ü                    ü     

Short Term Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü  2         ü         ü         ü     

Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Small Cap Growth Fund II

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

Small Cap Index Fund

   ü                                ü     

Small Cap Value Fund II

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü                    ü     

South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                          ü     

 

164


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares1
     Class C
Shares
     Class I
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class R4
Shares
     Shares      Class W
Shares
     Class  Y
Shares3
     Class Z
Shares
 

Total Return Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü                           ü     

 

1

Class B shares of the Funds are closed to new investments, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares. Additional Class B shares of the Funds will be issued only in connection with (i) reinvestment of dividends and/or capital gain distributions in Class B shares of each Fund by the Fund’s existing Class B shareholders and (ii) exchanges by shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Columbia Fund may exchange those shares for Class B shares of a Fund. See the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds for details.

2

Class R4 shares of Mid Cap Value Fund, Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund and Short Term Bond Fund have not commenced operations as of the date of this SAI.

3

The Funds also offers Class Y shares, which are included in a different statement of additional information.

Restrictions on Holding or Disposing of Shares

There are no restrictions on the right of shareholders to retain or dispose of the Funds’ shares, other than the possible future termination of the Funds. The Funds may be terminated by reorganization into another mutual fund or by liquidation and distribution of their assets. Unless terminated by reorganization or liquidation, the Funds will continue indefinitely.

Shareholder Liability

The Trust is organized under Delaware law, which provides that shareholders of a statutory trust are entitled to the same limitations of personal liability as shareholders of a corporation organized under Delaware law. Effectively, this means that a shareholder of the Funds will not be personally liable for payment of the Funds’ debts except by reason of his or her own conduct or acts. In addition, a shareholder could incur a financial loss on account of the Funds’ obligation only if the Funds had no remaining assets with which to meet such obligation. We believe that the possibility of such a situation arising is extremely remote.

Dividend Rights

The shareholders of a Fund are entitled to receive any dividends or other distributions declared for the Fund. No shares have priority or preference over any other shares of the Funds with respect to distributions. Distributions will be made from the assets of the Funds, and will be paid pro rata to all shareholders of each Fund (or class) according to the number of shares of each Fund (or class) held by shareholders on the record date. The amount of income dividends per share may vary between separate share classes of the Funds based upon differences in the way that expenses are allocated between share classes pursuant to a multiple class plan.

Voting Rights and Shareholder Meetings

Shareholders have the power to vote only as expressly granted under the 1940 Act or under Delaware statutory trust law. Shareholders have no independent right to vote on any matter, including the creation, operation, dissolution or termination of the Trust. Shareholders have the right to vote on other matters only as the Board authorizes. Currently, the 1940 Act requires that shareholders have the right to vote, under certain circumstances, to: (i) elect Trustees; (ii) approve investment advisory agreements and principal underwriting agreements; (iii) approve a change in subclassification of a Fund; (iv) approve any change in fundamental investment policies; (v) approve a distribution plan under Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act; and (vi) to terminate the independent accountant. With respect to matters that affect one class but not another, shareholders vote as a

 

165


Table of Contents

class; for example, the approval of a distribution plan applicable to that class. Subject to the foregoing, all shares of the Trust have equal voting rights and will be voted in the aggregate, and not by Fund, except where voting by Fund is required by law or where the matter involved only affects one Fund. For example, a change in a Fund’s fundamental investment policy affects only one Fund and would be voted upon only by shareholders of the Fund involved. Additionally, approval of an investment advisory agreement or investment subadvisory agreement, since it only affects one Fund, is a matter to be determined separately by each Fund. Approval by the shareholders of one Fund is effective as to that Fund whether or not sufficient votes are received from the shareholders of the other series to approve the proposal as to those Funds. Shareholders are entitled to one vote for each whole share held and a proportional fractional vote for each fractional vote held, on matters on which they are entitled to vote. Fund shareholders do not have cumulative voting rights. The Trust is not required to hold, and has no present intention of holding, annual meetings of shareholders.

Liquidation Rights

In the event of the liquidation or dissolution of the Trust or the Funds, shareholders of the Funds are entitled to receive the assets attributable to the relevant class of shares of the Funds that are available for distribution and to a distribution of any general assets not attributable to a particular investment portfolio that are available for distribution in such manner and on such basis as the Board may determine.

Preemptive Rights

There are no preemptive rights associated with Fund shares.

Conversion Rights

With the exception of Class B shares, which no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares as described in the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds, shareholders have the right, which is subject to change by the Board, to convert or “exchange” shares of one class for another. Such right is outlined and subject to certain conditions set forth in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Redemptions

Each Fund’s dividend, distribution and redemption policies can be found in its prospectuses under the headings Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares and Distributions and Taxes. However, the Board may suspend the right of shareholders to sell shares when permitted or required to do so by law or compel sales of shares in certain cases.

Sinking Fund Provisions

The Trust has no sinking fund provisions.

Calls or Assessment

All Fund shares are issued in uncertificated form only and when issued will be fully paid and non-assessable by the Trust.

 

166


Table of Contents

 

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

Purchase and Redemption

An investor may buy, sell and exchange shares in the Funds utilizing the methods, and subject to the restrictions, described in the Funds’ prospectuses. The following information supplements information in the Funds’ prospectuses.

The Funds have authorized one or more broker/dealers to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. These broker/dealers are authorized to designate other intermediaries to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. The Funds will be deemed to have received a buy or sell order when an authorized broker/dealer, or, if applicable, a broker/dealer’s authorized designee, accepts the order. Customer orders will be priced at each Fund’s net asset value next computed after they are accepted by an authorized broker/dealer or the broker’s authorized designee.

The Trust also may make payment for sales in readily marketable securities or other property if it is appropriate to do so in light of the Trust’s responsibilities under the 1940 Act.

Under the 1940 Act, the Funds may suspend the right of redemption or postpone the date of payment for shares during any period when (i) trading on the NYSE is restricted by applicable rules and regulations of the SEC; (ii) the NYSE is closed for other than customary weekend and holiday closings; (iii) the SEC has by order permitted such suspension; (iv) an emergency exists as determined by the SEC. (The Funds may also suspend or postpone the recordation of the transfer of their shares upon the occurrence of any of the foregoing conditions).

The Trust has elected to be governed by Rule 18f-1 under the 1940 Act, as a result of which each Fund is obligated to redeem shares, subject to the exceptions listed above, with respect to any one shareholder during any 90-day period, solely in cash up to the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the net asset value of each Fund at the beginning of the period.

Tax-Advantaged Retirement Plans (Retirement Plans)

The Transfer Agent maintains prototype tax-qualified plans, including Pension and Profit-Sharing Plans, for individuals, corporations, employees and the self-employed. The minimum initial Retirement Plan investment is $1,000, applied at the plan level. BANA is the custodian/trustee and plan sponsor of the Columbia Management prototype plans offered through the Distributor. In general a $20 annual fee is charged.

Participants in Retirement Plans not sponsored by BANA, not including IRAs, may be subject to an annual fee of $20 unless the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account with the Transfer Agent. Participants in BANA sponsored prototype plans (other than IRAs) who liquidate the total value of their account may also be charged a $20 close-out processing fee payable to the Transfer Agent. The close-out fee applies to plans opened after September 1, 1996. The fee is in addition to any applicable CDSC. The fee will not apply if the participant uses the proceeds to open a Columbia Management IRA Rollover account in any fund distributed by the Distributor, or if the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account.

Consultation with a competent financial advisor regarding these Retirement Plans and consideration of the suitability of fund shares as an investment under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or otherwise is recommended.

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

167


Table of Contents

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R shares and Class R4 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R shares and Class R4 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

 

168


Table of Contents

 

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.
** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

169


Table of Contents

 

Anti-Money Laundering Compliance

The Funds are required to comply with various anti-money laundering laws and regulations. Consequently, the Funds may request additional required information from you to verify your identity. Your application will be rejected if it does not contain your name, social security number, date of birth and permanent street address. If at any time the Funds believe a shareholder may be involved in suspicious activity or if certain account information matches information on government lists of suspicious persons, the Funds may choose not to establish a new account or may be required to “freeze” a shareholder’s account. The Funds also may be required to provide a governmental agency with information about transactions that have occurred in a shareholder’s account or to transfer monies received to establish a new account, transfer an existing account or transfer the proceeds of an existing account to a governmental agency. In some circumstances, the law may not permit the Funds to inform the shareholder that it has taken the actions described above.

Offering Price

The share price of each Fund is based on each Fund’s net asset value per share, which is calculated separately for each class of shares as of the close of regular trading on the NYSE (which is usually 4:00 p.m. Eastern time unless the NYSE closes earlier) on each day the Funds are open for business, unless the Board determines otherwise.

The value of each Fund’s portfolio securities for which a market quotation is available is determined in accordance with the Trust’s valuation procedures. In general terms, the valuation procedures provide that domestic exchange traded securities (other than NASDAQ listed equity securities) generally will be valued at their last traded sale prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. If no sales of those securities are reported on a particular day on the principal exchange, the securities generally will be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. Securities traded on a foreign securities exchange will generally be valued at their last sale prices on the exchange where the securities are primarily traded, or in the absence of a reported sale on a particular day, at their bid prices (in the case of securities held long) or ask prices (in the case of securities held short) as reported by that exchange. Securities traded primarily on NASDAQ will generally be valued at the NASDAQ Official Closing Price (NOCP) (which is the last trade price at or before 4:00:02 p.m. (Eastern Time) adjusted up to NASDAQ’s best bid price if the last trade price is below such bid price or adjusted down to NASDAQ’s best ask price if the last trade price is above such ask price). If no NOCP is available, the security will generally be valued at the last sale price shown on NASDAQ prior to the calculation of the NAV of the Fund. If no sale price is shown on NASDAQ, the latest bid price will be used. If no sale price is shown and no latest bid price is available, the price will be deemed “stale” and the value will be determined in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

Securities not traded upon any exchange will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices based upon quotes furnished by the appropriate market makers. If quoted prices are unavailable or are believed to be inaccurate, market values will generally be determined based on quotes obtained from one or more broker(s) or dealer(s) or based on a price obtained from a reputable independent pricing service.

Financial futures will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price. Forward foreign currency contracts will generally be valued using market quotations from a widely used quotation system that reflects the current cost of covering or off-setting the contract. Exchange traded options will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price on their exchange. If there is no reported sale on the valuation date, the options will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices.

Over-the-counter derivatives will generally be valued at fair value in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

 

170


Table of Contents

 

Repurchase agreements will generally be valued at a price equal to the amount of the cash invested in the repurchase agreement at the time of valuation. The market value of the securities underlying a repurchase agreement will be determined in accordance with the procedures above, as appropriate, for the purpose of determining the adequacy of collateral.

Shares of open-end investment companies held in each Fund’s portfolio will generally be valued at the latest net asset value reported by the investment company.

Debt securities will generally be valued by a pricing service which may employ a matrix or other indications of value, including but not limited to broker quotes, to determine valuations for normal institutional size trading units. The matrix can take into account various factors including, without limitation, bids, yield spreads, and/or other market data and specific security characteristics (e.g., credit quality, maturity and coupon rate). Debt securities for which a pricing service does not furnish valuations and for which market quotations are readily available will generally be valued based on the mean of the latest bid prices obtained from one or more dealers. Debt securities with remaining maturities of 60 days or less will, absent unusual circumstances, be valued at amortized cost.

Securities for which market quotations are not readily available for any reason, including that the latest quotation is deemed unreliable or unreasonable, securities and other assets and liabilities are valued at “fair value” as determined in good faith by the Adviser’s valuation committee. In general, any one or more of the following factors may be taken into account in determining fair value: the fundamental analytical data relating to the security; the value of other financial instruments, including derivative securities, traded on other markets or among dealers; trading volumes on markets, exchanges, or among dealers; values of baskets of securities traded on other markets; changes in interest rates; observations from financial institutions; government (domestic or foreign) actions or pronouncements; other news events; information as to any transactions or offers with respect to the security; price and extent of public trading in similar securities of the issuer or comparable companies; nature and expected duration of the event, if any, giving rise to the valuation issue; pricing history of the security; the relative size of the position in the portfolio; and other relevant information.

With respect to securities traded on foreign markets, the following factors also may be relevant: the value of foreign securities traded on other foreign markets; ADR trading; closed-end fund trading; foreign currency exchange activity; and the trading of financial products that are tied to baskets of foreign securities, such as World Equity Benchmark Shares™.

The Board has determined, and the valuation procedures provide, that in certain circumstances it may be necessary to use an alternative valuation method, such as in-kind redemptions with affiliated benefit plans where the Department of Labor requires that valuation to be done in accordance with Rule 17a-7 of the 1940 Act.

 

171


Table of Contents

 

TAXATION

The following information supplements and should be read in conjunction with the section in the Funds’ prospectuses entitled “Distributions and Taxes.” The prospectuses generally describe the U.S. federal income tax treatment of distributions by the Funds. This section of the SAI provides additional information concerning U.S. federal income taxes. It is based on the Code, applicable Treasury Regulations, judicial authority, and administrative rulings and practice, all as in effect as of the date of this SAI and all of which are subject to change, including changes with retroactive effect. Except as specifically set forth below, the following discussion does not address any state, local or foreign tax matters.

A shareholder’s tax treatment may vary depending upon his or her particular situation. This discussion applies only to shareholders holding Fund shares as capital assets within the meaning of the Code. Except as otherwise noted, it may not apply to certain types of shareholders who may be subject to special rules, such as insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, shareholders holding Fund shares through tax-advantaged accounts (such as 401(k) Plan Accounts or Individual Retirement Accounts), financial institutions, broker-dealers, entities that are not organized under the laws of the United States or a political subdivision thereof, persons who are neither citizens nor residents of the United States, shareholders holding Fund shares as part of a hedge, straddle, or conversion transaction, and shareholders who are subject to the U.S. federal alternative minimum tax.

The Trust has not requested and will not request an advance ruling from the IRS as to the U.S. federal income tax matters described below. The IRS could adopt positions contrary to those discussed below and such positions could be sustained. In addition, the following discussion and the discussions in the prospectuses applicable to each shareholder address only some of the U.S. federal income tax considerations generally affecting investments in the Funds. Prospective shareholders are urged to consult with their own tax advisors and financial planners regarding the U.S. federal tax consequences of an investment in a Fund, the application of state, local, or foreign laws, and the effect of any possible changes in applicable tax laws on their investment in the Funds.

Qualification as a Regulated Investment Company

It is intended that each Fund qualify as a “regulated investment company” under Subchapter M of Subtitle A, Chapter 1 of the Code. Each Fund will be treated as a separate entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Thus, the provisions of the Code applicable to regulated investment companies generally will apply separately to each Fund, even though each Fund is a series of the Trust. Furthermore, each Fund will separately determine its income, gains, losses, and expenses for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

In order to qualify for the special tax treatment accorded regulated investment companies and their shareholders, each Fund must, among other things, derive at least 90% of its gross income each taxable year generally from (i) dividends, interest, certain payments with respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities or foreign currencies, or other income attributable to its business of investing in such stock, securities or foreign currencies (including, but not limited to, gains from options, futures or forward contracts) and (ii) net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership, as defined below. In general, for purposes of this 90% gross income requirement, income derived from a partnership (other than a qualified publicly traded partnership) will be treated as qualifying income only to the extent such income is attributable to items of income of the partnership which would be qualifying income if realized directly by the regulated investment company. However, 100% of the net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership (defined as a partnership (x) the interests in which are traded on an established securities market or readily tradable on a secondary market or the substantial equivalent thereof, (y) that derives at least 90% of its income from the passive income sources defined in Code Section 7704(d), and (z) that derives less than 90% of its income from the qualifying income described in clause (i) above) will be treated as qualifying income. Certain of a Fund’s investments in master limited partnerships (MLPs), if any, may

 

172


Table of Contents

qualify as interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, although in general the passive loss rules do not apply to a regulated investment company, such rules do apply to a regulated investment company with respect to items attributable to an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership.

Each Fund must also diversify its holdings so that, at the end of each quarter of the Fund’s taxable year: (i) at least 50% of the fair market value of its total assets consists of (A) cash and cash items (including receivables), U.S. government securities and securities of other regulated investment companies, and (B) securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (A)) to the extent such securities do not exceed 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets and are not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (ii) not more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s total assets consists of the securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (i)(A)), the securities of two or more issuers the Fund controls and which are engaged in the same, similar, or related trades or businesses, or the securities of one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, for purposes of meeting this diversification requirement, the term “outstanding voting securities of such issuer” includes the equity securities of a qualified publicly traded partnership and in the case of a Fund’s investments in loan participations, the Fund shall treat both the financial intermediary and the issuer of the underlying loan as an issuer. The qualifying income and diversification requirements described above may limit the extent to which a Fund can engage in certain derivative transactions, as well as the extent to which it can invest in MLPs.

In addition, each Fund generally must distribute to its shareholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income for the taxable year, which generally includes its ordinary income and the excess of any net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss, and at least 90% of its net tax-exempt interest income (if any) for the taxable year.

If a Fund qualifies as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment, it generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on any of the investment company taxable income and net capital gain (i.e., the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) it distributes to its shareholders (including Capital Gain Dividends, as defined below). Each Fund generally intends to distribute at least annually substantially all of its investment company taxable income (computed without regard to the dividends-paid deduction) and substantially all of its net capital gain. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to U.S. federal income taxation. Any investment company taxable income retained by a Fund will be subject to tax at regular corporate rates.

In addition, although each Fund generally intends to distribute all of its net capital gain, a Fund may determine to retain for investment all or a portion of its net capital gain. If a Fund retains any net capital gain, it will be subject to a tax at regular corporate rates on the amount retained, but may designate the retained amount as undistributed capital gains in a notice to its shareholders, who (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as long-term capital gain, their shares of such undistributed amount, and (ii) will be entitled to credit their proportionate shares of the tax paid by the Fund on such undistributed amount against their U.S. federal income tax liabilities, if any, and to claim refunds to the extent the credit exceeds such liabilities. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, the tax basis of shares owned by a shareholder of a Fund will be increased by an amount equal under current law to the difference between the amount of undistributed capital gains included in the shareholder’s gross income under clause (i) of the preceding sentence and the tax deemed paid by the shareholder under clause (ii) of the preceding sentence.

In determining its net capital gain for Capital Gain Dividend purposes, a regulated investment company generally must treat any net capital loss or any net long-term capital loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year. Treasury Regulations generally permit a regulated investment company, in determining its taxable income, to elect to treat all or part of any net capital loss, any net long-term capital loss or any foreign currency loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year.

 

173


Table of Contents

 

In order to comply with the distribution requirements described above applicable to regulated investment companies, a Fund generally must make the distributions in the same taxable year that it realizes the income and gain, although in certain circumstances, a Fund may make the distributions in the following taxable year in respect of income and gains from the prior taxable year. Shareholders generally are taxed on any distributions from a Fund in the year they are actually distributed. If a Fund declares a distribution to shareholders of record in October, November or December of one calendar year and pays the distribution by January 31 of the following calendar year, however, the Fund and its shareholders will be treated as if the Fund paid the distribution by December 31 of the earlier year.

If, for any taxable year, a Fund fails to qualify as a regulated investment company accorded special tax treatment under the Code, it will be taxed in the same manner as an ordinary corporation without any deduction for its distributions to shareholders, and all distributions from the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits (including any distributions of its net tax-exempt income and net long-term capital gains) to its shareholders will be taxable to shareholders as dividend income. In addition, the Fund could be required to recognize unrealized gains, pay substantial taxes and interest and make substantial distributions before requalifying as a regulated investment company.

Excise Tax

If a Fund fails to distribute by December 31 of each calendar year at least the sum of 98% of its ordinary income for that year (excluding capital gains and losses) and 98% of its capital gain net income (adjusted for net ordinary losses) for the 1-year period ending on October 31 of that year (or November 30 or December 31 of that year if the Fund is permitted to elect and so elects), and any of its ordinary income and capital gain net income from previous years that were not distributed during such years, the Fund will be subject to a nondeductible 4% excise tax on the undistributed amounts. For these purposes, a Fund will be treated as having distributed any amount on which it has been subject to corporate income tax in the taxable year ending within the calendar year. Each Fund generally intends to actually distribute or be deemed to have distributed substantially all of its ordinary income and capital gain net income, if any, by the end of each calendar year and, thus, expects not to be subject to the excise tax. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to the excise tax. Moreover, each Fund reserves the right to pay an excise tax rather than make an additional distribution when circumstances warrant (for example, if the amount of excise tax to be paid is deemed de minimis by a Fund).

Capital Loss Carryforwards

Subject to certain limitations, a Fund is permitted to carry forward a net capital loss from any year to offset its capital gains, if any, realized during the eight years following the year of the loss. A Fund’s capital loss carryforward is treated as a short-term capital loss in the year to which it is carried. If future capital gains are offset by carried forward capital losses, such future capital gains are not subject to fund-level U.S. federal income taxation, regardless of whether they are distributed to shareholders. Accordingly, the Funds do not expect to distribute any such offsetting capital gains. The Funds cannot carry back or carry forward any net operating losses.

Equalization Accounting

Each Fund may use the so-called “equalization method” of accounting to allocate a portion of its “accumulated earnings and profits,” which generally equals a Fund’s undistributed net investment income and realized capital gains, with certain adjustments, to redemption proceeds. This method permits a Fund to achieve more balanced distributions for both continuing and redeeming shareholders. Although using this method generally will not affect a Fund’s total returns, it may reduce the amount of income and gains that the Fund would otherwise distribute to continuing shareholders by reducing the effect of redemptions of Fund shares on Fund distributions to shareholders. The IRS has not sanctioned the particular equalization method used by the Funds, and thus a Fund’s use of this method may be subject to IRS scrutiny.

 

174


Table of Contents

 

Investment through Master Portfolios

Some Funds seek to continue to qualify as regulated investment companies by investing their assets through one or more Master Portfolios. Each Master Portfolio will be treated as a non-publicly traded partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes rather than as a regulated investment company or a corporation under the Code. Under the rules applicable to a non-publicly traded partnership, a proportionate share of any interest, dividends, gains and losses of a Master Portfolio will be deemed to have been realized (i.e., “passed through”) to its investors, including the corresponding Fund, regardless of whether any amounts are actually distributed by the Master Portfolio. Each investor in a Master Portfolio will be taxed on such share, as determined in accordance with the governing instruments of the particular Master Portfolio, the Code and Treasury Regulations, in determining such investor’s U.S. federal income tax liability. Therefore, to the extent a Master Portfolio were to accrue but not distribute any income or gains, the corresponding Fund would be deemed to have realized its proportionate share of such income or gains without receipt of any corresponding distribution. However, each of the Master Portfolios will seek to minimize recognition by its investors (such as a corresponding Fund) of income and gains without a corresponding distribution. Furthermore, each Master Portfolio intends to manage its assets, income and distributions in such a way that an investor in a Master Portfolio will be able to continue to qualify as a regulated investment company by investing its assets through the Master Portfolio.

Taxation of Fund Investments

In general, realized gains or losses on the sale of securities held by a Fund will be treated as capital gains or losses, and long-term capital gains or losses if the Fund has held or is deemed to have held the securities for more than one year at the time of disposition.

If a Fund purchases a debt obligation with original issue discount (OID) (generally a debt obligation with an issue price less than its stated principal amount, such as a zero-coupon bond), the Fund may be required to annually include in its income a portion of the OID as ordinary income, even though the Fund will not receive cash payments for such discount until maturity or disposition of the obligation. Inflation-protected bonds generally can be expected to produce OID income as their principal amounts are adjusted upward for inflation. In general, gains recognized on the disposition of (or the receipt of any partial payment of principal on) a debt obligation (including a municipal obligation) purchased by a Fund at a market discount, generally at a price less than its principal amount, will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the portion of market discount which accrued, but was not previously recognized pursuant to an available election, during the term that the Fund held the debt obligation. A Fund generally will be required to make distributions to shareholders representing the OID or market discount (if an election is made by the Fund to accrue market discount over the holding period of the applicable debt obligation) on debt securities that is currently includible in income, even though the cash representing such income may not have been received by the Fund. Cash to pay such distributions may be obtained from borrowing or from sales proceeds of securities held by a Fund which the Fund otherwise might have continued to hold; obtaining such cash might be disadvantageous for the Fund.

In addition, payment-in-kind securities similarly will give rise to income which is required to be distributed and is taxable even though a Fund receives no cash interest payment on the security during the year. A portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations (such as high-yield corporate debt securities) may not (and interest paid on debt obligations owned by a Fund that are considered for tax purposes to be payable in the equity of the issuer or a related party will not) be deductible to the issuer, possibly affecting the cash flow of the issuer.

If a Fund invests in debt obligations that are in the lowest rating categories or are unrated, including debt obligations of issuers not currently paying interest or who are in default, special tax issues may exist for the Fund. Tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as whether a Fund should recognize market discount on a debt obligation and, if so, the amount of market discount the Fund should recognize, when a Fund may cease to accrue interest, OID or market discount, when and to what extent deductions may be taken for bad debts or

 

175


Table of Contents

worthless securities and how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income. These and other related issues will be addressed by a Fund when, as and if it invests in such securities, in order to seek to ensure that it distributes sufficient income to preserve its status as a regulated investment company and does not become subject to U.S. federal income or excise tax.

If an option granted by a Fund is sold, lapses or is otherwise terminated through a closing transaction, such as a repurchase by the Fund of the option from its holder, the Fund generally will realize a short-term capital gain or loss, depending on whether the premium income is greater or less than the amount paid by the Fund in the closing transaction. Some capital losses realized by a Fund in the sale, exchange, exercise or other disposition of an option may be deferred if they result from a position that is part of a “straddle,” discussed below. If securities are sold by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a covered call option granted by it, the Fund generally will add the premium received to the sale price of the securities delivered in determining the amount of gain or loss on the sale. If securities are purchased by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a put option written by it, the Fund generally will subtract the premium received from its cost basis in the securities purchased.

Some regulated futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity, listed options that may be used by a Fund will be deemed “Section 1256 contracts.” A Fund will be required to “mark to market” any such contracts held at the end of the taxable year by treating them as if they had been sold on the last day of that year at market value. Sixty percent of any net gain or loss realized on all dispositions of Section 1256 contracts, including deemed dispositions under the “mark-to-market” rule, generally will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss, and the remaining 40% will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss, although certain foreign currency gains and losses from such contracts may be treated as ordinary income or loss as described below. These provisions may require a Fund to recognize income or gains without a concurrent receipt of cash. Transactions that qualify as designated hedges are exempt from the mark-to-market rule and the “60%/40%” rule and may require the Fund to defer the recognition of losses on certain futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity options.

Foreign exchange gains and losses realized by a Fund in connection with certain transactions involving foreign currency-denominated debt securities, certain options, futures contracts, forward contracts and similar instruments relating to foreign currency, foreign currencies, or payables or receivables denominated in a foreign currency are subject to Section 988 of the Code, which generally causes such gains and losses to be treated as ordinary income or loss and may affect the amount and timing of recognition of the Fund’s income. Under future Treasury Regulations, any such transactions that are not directly related to a Fund’s investments in stock or securities (or its options contracts or futures contracts with respect to stock or securities) may have to be limited in order to enable the Fund to satisfy the 90% qualifying income test described above. If the net foreign exchange loss exceeds a Fund’s net investment company taxable income (computed without regard to such loss) for a taxable year, the resulting ordinary loss for such year will not be available as a carryforward and thus cannot be deducted by the Fund or its shareholders in future years.

Offsetting positions held by a Fund involving certain derivative instruments, such as forward, futures and options contracts, may be considered, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to constitute “straddles.” “Straddles” are defined to include “offsetting positions” in actively traded personal property. The tax treatment of “straddles” is governed by Section 1092 of the Code which, in certain circumstances, overrides or modifies the provisions of Section 1256. If a Fund is treated as entering into a “straddle” and at least one (but not all) of the Fund’s positions in derivative contracts comprising a part of such straddle is governed by Section 1256 of the Code, described above, then such straddle could be characterized as a “mixed straddle.” A Fund may make one or more elections with respect to “mixed straddles.” Depending upon which election is made, if any, the results with respect to a Fund may differ. Generally, to the extent the straddle rules apply to positions established by a Fund, losses realized by the Fund may be deferred to the extent of unrealized gain in any offsetting positions. Moreover, as a result of the straddle rules, short-term capital loss on straddle positions may be recharacterized as long-term capital loss, and long-term capital gain may be characterized as short-term capital gain. In addition, the existence of a straddle may affect the holding period of the offsetting positions. As a result, the straddle rules

 

176


Table of Contents

could cause distributions that would otherwise constitute “qualified dividend income” or qualify for the dividends-received deduction to fail to satisfy the applicable holding period requirements (as described below). Furthermore, the Fund may be required to capitalize, rather than deduct currently, any interest expense and carrying charges applicable to a position that is part of a straddle, including any interest on indebtedness incurred or continued to purchase or carry any positions that are part of a straddle. The application of the straddle rules to certain offsetting Fund positions can therefore affect the amount, timing, and character of distributions to shareholders, and may result in significant differences from the amount, timing and character of distributions that would have been made by the Fund if it had not entered into offsetting positions in respect of certain of its portfolio securities.

If a Fund enters into a “constructive sale” of any appreciated financial position in stock, a partnership interest, or certain debt instruments, the Fund will be treated as if it had sold and immediately repurchased the property and must recognize gain (but not loss) with respect to that position. A constructive sale of an appreciated financial position occurs when a Fund enters into certain offsetting transactions with respect to the same or substantially identical property, including, but not limited to: (i) a short sale; (ii) an offsetting notional principal contract; (iii) a futures or forward contract; or (iv) other transactions identified in future Treasury Regulations. The character of the gain from constructive sales will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the appreciated financial position. Losses realized from a sale of a position that was previously the subject of a constructive sale will be recognized when the position is subsequently disposed of. The character of such losses will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the position beginning with the date the constructive sale was deemed to have occurred and the application of various loss deferral provisions in the Code. Constructive sale treatment does not apply to certain closed transactions, including if such a transaction is closed on or before the 30th day after the close of the Fund’s taxable year and the Fund holds the appreciated financial position unhedged throughout the 60-day period beginning with the day such transaction was closed.

The amount of long-term capital gain a Fund may recognize from certain derivative transactions with respect to interests in certain pass-through entities is limited under the Code’s constructive ownership rules. The amount of long-term capital gain is limited to the amount of such gain the Fund would have had if the Fund directly invested in the pass-through entity during the term of the derivative contract. Any gain in excess of this amount is treated as ordinary income. An interest charge is imposed on the amount of gain that is treated as ordinary income.

If a Fund makes a distribution of income received by the Fund in lieu of dividends (a “substitute payment”) with respect to securities on loan pursuant to a securities lending transaction, such income will not constitute qualified dividend income to individual shareholders and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction for corporate shareholders. Similar consequences may apply to repurchase and other derivative transactions. Similarly, to the extent that a Fund makes distributions of income received by such Fund in lieu of tax-exempt interest with respect to securities on loan, such distributions will not constitute exempt-interest dividends (defined below) to shareholders.

In addition, a Fund’s transactions in securities and certain types of derivatives (e.g., options, futures contracts, forward contracts and swap agreements) may be subject to other special tax rules, such as the wash-sale rules or the short-sale rules, the effect of which may be to accelerate income to the Fund, defer losses to the Fund, cause adjustments in the holding periods of the Fund’s securities, convert long-term capital gains into short-term capital gains, and/or convert short-term capital losses into long-term capital losses. These rules could therefore affect the amount, timing and character of distributions to shareholders.

Certain of a Fund’s investments in derivative instruments and foreign currency-denominated instruments, as well as any of its foreign currency transactions and hedging activities, are likely to produce a difference between its book income and its taxable income. If a Fund’s book income exceeds the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the distribution (if any) of such excess generally will be treated as (i) a dividend to the extent of the Fund’s remaining earnings and profits (including earnings and profits arising from tax-exempt

 

177


Table of Contents

income), (ii) thereafter, as a return of capital to the extent of the recipient’s basis in its shares, and (iii) thereafter, as gain from the sale or exchange of a capital asset. If a Fund’s book income is less than the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the Fund could be required to make distributions exceeding book income to qualify as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment.

Rules governing the U.S. federal income tax aspects of derivatives, including swap agreements, are in a developing stage and are not entirely clear in certain respects. Accordingly, while each Fund intends to account for such transactions in a manner it deems to be appropriate, an adverse determination or future guidance by the IRS with respect to these rules (which determination or guidance could be retroactive) may affect whether a Fund has made sufficient distributions, and otherwise satisfied the relevant requirements to maintain its qualification as a regulated investment company and avoid fund-level tax. Certain requirements that must be met under the Code in order for a Fund to qualify as a regulated investment company may limit the extent to which a Fund will be able to engage in certain derivatives transactions.

Any investment by a Fund in equity securities of a REIT may result in the Fund’s receipt of cash in excess of the REIT’s earnings; if the Fund distributes these amounts, these distributions could constitute a return of capital to Fund shareholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Investments in equity securities of a REIT or another regulated investment company also may require a Fund to accrue and distribute income not yet received. To generate sufficient cash to make the requisite distributions, the Fund may be required to sell securities in its portfolio (including when it is not advantageous to do so) that it otherwise would have continued to hold. Dividends received by the Fund from a REIT generally will not constitute qualified dividend income and will not qualify for the dividends-received deduction.

A Fund may invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in taxable mortgage pools (TMPs). Under an IRS notice, and Treasury Regulations that have yet to be issued but may apply retroactively, a portion of a Fund’s income (including income allocated to the Fund from a REIT, a regulated investment company or other pass-through entity) that is attributable to a residual interest in a REMIC or an equity interest in a TMP (referred to in the Code as an “excess inclusion”) will be subject to U.S. federal income tax in all events. This notice also provides, and the regulations are expected to provide, that excess inclusion income of a regulated investment company, such as a Fund, will be allocated to shareholders of the regulated investment company in proportion to the dividends received by such shareholders, with the same consequences as if the shareholders held the related interest directly. As a result, the Fund may not be a suitable investment for certain tax-exempt shareholders, as noted under “Tax-Exempt Shareholders” below.

In general, excess inclusion income allocated to shareholders (i) cannot be offset by net operating losses (subject to a limited exception for certain thrift institutions), (ii) will constitute unrelated business taxable income (UBTI) to entities (including a qualified pension plan, an individual retirement account, a 401(k) plan, a Keogh plan or certain other tax-exempt entities) subject to tax on UBTI, thereby potentially requiring such an entity that is allocated excess inclusion income, and otherwise might not be required to file a tax return, to file a tax return and pay tax on such income, and (iii) in the case of a foreign shareholder, will not qualify for any reduction in U.S. federal withholding tax.

Some amounts received by a Fund from its investments in MLPs will likely be treated as returns of capital because of accelerated deductions available with respect to the activities of MLPs. On the disposition of an investment in such an MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of economic gain from that asset (or if a Fund does not dispose of the MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of cash flow received by the Fund from the MLP in a later period), and the Fund must take such income into account in determining whether the Fund has satisfied its regulated investment company distribution requirements. The Fund may have to borrow or liquidate securities to satisfy its distribution requirements and meet its redemption requests, even though investment considerations might otherwise make it undesirable for the Fund to borrow money or sell securities at the time. In addition, distributions attributable to gain from the sale of MLPs that are characterized as ordinary income under the Code’s recapture provisions will be taxable to Fund shareholders as ordinary income.

 

178


Table of Contents

 

“Passive foreign investment companies” (PFICs) are generally defined as foreign corporations where at least 75% of their gross income for their taxable year is income from passive sources (such as certain interest, dividends, rents and royalties, or capital gains) or at least 50% of their assets on average produce such passive income. If a Fund acquires any equity interest in a PFIC, the Fund could be subject to U.S. federal income tax and interest charges on “excess distributions” received from the PFIC or on gain from the sale of such equity interest in the PFIC, even if all income or gain actually received by the Fund is timely distributed to its shareholders. Excess distributions and gain from the sale of interests in PFICs may be characterized as ordinary income even though, absent the application of PFIC rules, these amounts may otherwise have been classified as capital gain.

A Fund will not be permitted to pass through to its shareholders any credit or deduction for these special taxes and interest charges incurred with respect to a PFIC. Elections may be available that would ameliorate these adverse tax consequences, but such elections would require a Fund to include its share of the PFIC’s income and net capital gains annually, regardless of whether it receives any distribution from the PFIC (in the case of a “QEF election”), or to mark the gains (and to a limited extent losses) in its interests in the PFIC “to the market” as though the Fund had sold and repurchased such interests on the last day of the Fund’s taxable year, treating such gains and losses as ordinary income and loss (in the case of a “mark-to-market election”). The QEF and mark-to-market elections may require a Fund to recognize taxable income or gain without the concurrent receipt of cash and increase the amount required to be distributed by the Fund to avoid taxation. Making either of these elections therefore may require a Fund to liquidate other investments prematurely to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above, which also may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return. Each Fund may attempt to limit and/or manage its holdings in PFICs to minimize tax liability and/or maximize returns from these investments but there can be no assurance that it will be able to do so. Moreover, because it is not always possible to identify a foreign corporation as a PFIC in advance of acquiring shares in the corporation, a Fund may incur the tax and interest charges described above in some instances. Dividends paid by PFICs will not be eligible to be treated as qualified dividend income, as defined below.

In addition to the investments described above, prospective shareholders should be aware that other investments made by a Fund may involve complex tax rules that may result in income or gain recognition by the Fund without corresponding current cash receipts. Although each Fund seeks to avoid significant noncash income, such noncash income could be recognized by a Fund, in which case the Fund may distribute cash derived from other sources in order to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above. In this regard, a Fund could be required at times to liquidate investments prematurely in order to satisfy its minimum distribution requirements, which may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return.

Taxation of Distributions

Except for exempt-interest dividends (defined below) paid by a Fund, distributions paid out of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits, whether paid in cash or reinvested in the Fund, generally are deemed to be taxable distributions and must be reported by each shareholder who is required to file a U.S. federal income tax return. Dividends and distributions on a Fund’s shares are generally subject to U.S. federal income tax as described herein to the extent they do not exceed the Fund’s realized income and gains, even though such dividends and distributions may economically represent a return of a particular shareholder’s investment. Such distributions are likely to occur in respect of shares purchased at a time when the Fund’s net asset value reflects either unrealized gains, or realized but undistributed income or gains. Such realized income and gains may be required to be distributed even when the Fund’s net asset value also reflects unrealized losses. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, a Fund’s earnings and profits, described above, are determined at the end of the Fund’s taxable year and are allocated pro rata to distributions paid over the entire year. Distributions in excess of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits will first be treated as a return of capital up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares and then as capital gain. A return of capital is not taxable, but

 

179


Table of Contents

it reduces a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares, thus reducing any loss or increasing any gain on a subsequent taxable disposition by the shareholder of his or her shares. A Fund may make distributions in excess of its earnings and profits to a limited extent, from time to time.

For U.S. federal income tax purposes, distributions of investment income (except for exempt-interest dividends, defined below) are generally taxable as ordinary income, and distributions of gains from the sale of investments that a Fund owned (or is deemed to have owned) for one year or less will be taxable as ordinary income. Distributions properly designated by a Fund as capital gain dividends (Capital Gain Dividends) will be taxable to shareholders as long-term capital gain (to the extent such distributions do not exceed the Fund’s actual net long-term capital gain for the taxable year), regardless of how long a shareholder has held Fund shares, and do not qualify as dividends for purposes of the dividends-received deduction or as qualified dividend income (defined below). Each Fund will designate Capital Gain Dividends, if any, in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year.

Some states will not tax distributions made to individual shareholders that are attributable to interest a Fund earns on direct obligations of the U.S. government if the Fund meets the state’s minimum investment or reporting requirements, if any. Investments in GNMA or FNMA securities, bankers’ acceptances, commercial paper, and repurchase agreements collateralized by U.S. government securities generally do not qualify for tax-free treatment. This exemption may not apply to corporate shareholders.

Sales and Exchanges of Fund Shares

If a shareholder sells or exchanges his or her Fund shares, he or she generally will realize a taxable capital gain or loss on the difference between the amount received for the shares (or deemed received in the case of an exchange) and his or her tax basis in the shares. This gain or loss will be long-term capital gain or loss if he or she has held (or is deemed to have held) such Fund shares for more than one year at the time of the sale or exchange, and short-term capital gain or loss otherwise.

If a shareholder sells or exchanges Fund shares within 90 days of having acquired such shares and if, as a result of having initially acquired those shares, he or she subsequently pays a reduced sales charge on a new purchase of shares of the Fund or a different regulated investment company, the sales charge previously incurred in acquiring the Fund’s shares generally shall not be taken into account (to the extent the previous sales charges do not exceed the reduction in sales charges on the new purchase) for the purpose of determining the amount of gain or loss on the disposition, but generally will be treated as having been incurred in the new purchase. Also, if a shareholder realizes a loss on a disposition of Fund shares, the loss will be disallowed under “wash sale” rules to the extent that he or she purchases substantially identical shares within the 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the disposition. Any disallowed loss generally will be reflected in an adjustment to the tax basis of the purchased shares.

If a shareholder receives a Capital Gain Dividend or is deemed to receive a distribution of long-term capital gain with respect to any Fund share and such Fund share is held or treated as held for six months or less, then (unless otherwise disallowed) any loss on the sale or exchange of that Fund share will be treated as a long-term capital loss to the extent of the Capital Gain Dividend or deemed long-term capital gain distribution. If shares of a Fund are sold at a loss after being held for six months or less, the loss will be disallowed to the extent of any exempt-interest dividends (defined below) received on those shares.

Foreign Taxes

Amounts realized by a Fund from sources within foreign countries may be subject to withholding and other taxes imposed by such countries. Tax conventions between certain countries and the United States may reduce or eliminate such taxes. If more than 50% of the value of a Fund’s total assets at the close of its taxable year consists of securities of foreign corporations, the Fund will be eligible to file an annual election with the IRS

 

180


Table of Contents

pursuant to which the Fund may pass through to its shareholders on a pro rata basis foreign income and similar taxes paid by the Fund with respect to foreign securities that the Fund has held for at least the minimum holding periods specified in the Code and such taxes may be claimed, subject to certain limitations, either as a tax credit or deduction by the shareholders. A Fund that invests primarily or exclusively in other regulated investment companies would not be eligible for this election, even if the underlying regulated investment companies were eligible and did make the election.

Certain Funds may qualify for and make the election; however, even if a Fund qualifies for the election for any year, it may determine not to make the election for such year. If a Fund does not so qualify or qualifies but does not so elect, then shareholders will not be entitled to claim a credit or deduction with respect to foreign taxes paid by or withheld from payments to the Fund. A Fund will notify its shareholders within 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year if it has elected for the foreign taxes paid by it to “pass through” for that year.

In general, if a Fund makes the election, the Fund itself will not be permitted to claim a credit or deduction for foreign taxes paid in that year, and the Fund’s dividends-paid deduction will be increased by the amount of foreign taxes paid that year. Fund shareholders generally shall include their proportionate share of the foreign taxes paid by the Fund in their gross income and treat that amount as paid by them for the purpose of the foreign tax credit or deduction, provided that any applicable holding period and other requirements have been met. If a shareholder claims a credit for foreign taxes paid, in general, the credit will be subject to certain limits. A deduction for foreign taxes paid may be claimed only by shareholders that itemize their deductions.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Rates

As of the date of this SAI, the maximum stated U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to individuals generally is 35% for ordinary income and 15% for net long-term capital gain. Long-term capital gain rates applicable to individuals have been temporarily reduced — in general, to 15% with lower rates applying to taxpayers in the 10% and 15% rate brackets — for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

For taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011, U.S. federal income tax law also provides for a maximum individual U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to “qualified dividend income” equal to the highest net long-term capital gain rate, which, as described above, generally is 15%. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011. In general, “qualified dividend income” is income attributable to dividends received by a Fund from certain domestic and foreign corporations, as long as certain holding period and other requirements are met by the Fund with respect to the dividend-paying corporation’s stock and by the shareholders with respect to the Fund’s shares. If 95% or more of a Fund’s gross income (excluding net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) constitutes qualified dividend income, all of its distributions (other than Capital Gain Dividends) will be generally treated as qualified dividend income in the hands of individual shareholders, as long as they have owned their Fund shares for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the Fund’s ex-dividend date (or, in the case of certain preferred stock, 91 days during the 181-day period beginning 90 days before such date) and meet certain other requirements specified in the Code. In general, if less than 95% of a Fund’s income is attributable to qualified dividend income, then only the portion of the Fund’s distributions that is attributable to qualified dividend income and designated as such in a timely manner will be so treated in the hands of individual shareholders who meet the aforementioned holding period requirements. The rules regarding the qualification of Fund distributions as qualified dividend income are complex, including the holding period requirements. Individual Fund shareholders therefore are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners. Fixed income funds typically do not distribute significant amounts of qualified dividend income.

The maximum stated corporate U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to ordinary income and net capital gain is 35%. Actual marginal tax rates may be higher for some shareholders, for example, through reductions in deductions. Naturally, the amount of tax payable by any taxpayer will be affected by a combination of tax laws

 

181


Table of Contents

covering, for example, deductions, credits, deferrals, exemptions, sources of income and other matters. U.S. federal income tax rates are set to increase in future years under various “sunset” provisions of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Backup Withholding

Each Fund generally is required to withhold, and remit to the U.S. Treasury, subject to certain exemptions, an amount equal to 28% of all distributions and redemption proceeds (including proceeds from exchanges and redemptions in-kind) paid or credited to a Fund shareholder if (1) the shareholder fails to furnish the Fund with a correct “taxpayer identification number” (TIN) or has not certified to the Fund that withholding does not apply or (2) the IRS notifies the Fund that the shareholder’s TIN is incorrect or the shareholder is otherwise subject to backup withholding. These backup withholding rules may also apply to distributions that are properly designated as exempt-interest dividends (defined below). This backup withholding is not an additional tax imposed on the shareholder. The shareholder may apply amounts required to be withheld as a credit against his or her future U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS. If a shareholder fails to furnish a valid TIN upon request, the shareholder can also be subject to IRS penalties. Unless Congress enacts legislation providing otherwise, the rate of backup withholding is set to increase to 31% for amounts distributed or paid after December 31, 2010.

Tax-Deferred Plans

The shares of a Fund may be available for a variety of tax-deferred retirement and other tax-advantaged plans and accounts. Prospective investors should contact their tax advisors and financial planners regarding the tax consequences to them of holding Fund shares through such plans and/or accounts.

Corporate Shareholders

Subject to limitations and other rules, a corporate shareholder of a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction on Fund distributions attributable to dividends received by the Fund from domestic corporations, which, if received directly by the corporate shareholder, would qualify for such a deduction. For eligible corporate shareholders, the dividends-received deduction may be subject to certain reductions, and a distribution by a Fund attributable to dividends of a domestic corporation will be eligible for the deduction only if certain holding period and other requirements are met. These requirements are complex; therefore, corporate shareholders of the Funds are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners.

As discussed above, a portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations that a Fund may own may not be deductible to the issuer. If a portion of the interest paid or accrued on these obligations is not deductible, that portion will be treated as a dividend. In such cases, if the issuer of the obligation is a domestic corporation, dividend payments by a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction to the extent of the dividend portion of such interest.

Foreign Shareholders

For purposes of this discussion, “foreign shareholders” generally include: (i) nonresident alien individuals, (ii) foreign trusts (i.e., a trust other than a trust with respect to which a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over administration of that trust and one or more U.S. persons have authority to control substantial decisions of that trust), (iii) foreign estates (i.e., the income of which is not subject to U.S. tax regardless of source), and (iv) foreign corporations.

Generally, unless an exception applies, dividend distributions made to foreign shareholders other than Capital Gain Dividends and exempt-interest dividends (defined below) will be subject to non-refundable U.S. federal income tax withholding at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income

 

182


Table of Contents

tax treaty) even if they are funded by income or gains (such as portfolio interest, short-term capital gains, or foreign-source dividend and interest income) that, if paid to a foreign person directly, would not be subject to withholding. However, generally, for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions made to foreign shareholders and properly designated by a Fund as “interest-related dividends” were exempt from U.S. federal income tax withholding. The exemption for interest-related dividends did not apply to any distribution to a foreign shareholder (i) to the extent that the dividend was attributable to certain interest on an obligation if the foreign shareholder was the issuer or was a 10% shareholder of the issuer, (ii) that was within certain foreign countries that had inadequate information exchange with the United States, or (iii) to the extent the dividend was attributable to interest paid by a person that was a related person of the foreign shareholder and the foreign shareholder was a controlled foreign corporation. Interest-related dividends were generally attributable to the Fund’s net U.S.-source interest income of types similar to those not subject to U.S. federal income tax if earned directly by an individual foreign shareholder. In order to qualify as an interest-related dividend, the Fund was required to designate a distribution as such in a written notice mailed to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a distribution described above is “effectively connected” with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, is attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the recipient foreign shareholder, U.S. federal income tax withholding will not apply. Instead, the distribution will be subject to the tax, reporting and withholding requirements generally applicable to U.S. persons, and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the recipient foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation.

In general, a foreign shareholder’s capital gains realized on the disposition of Fund shares and distributions properly designated as Capital Gain Dividends are not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax, unless: (i) such gains or distributions are effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, are attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the foreign shareholder; (ii) in the case of an individual foreign shareholder, the shareholder is present in the U.S. for a period or periods aggregating 183 days or more during the year of the disposition of Fund shares or the receipt of Capital Gain Dividends and certain other conditions are met; or (iii) the Fund shares on which the foreign shareholder realized gain constitute U.S. real property interests (USRPIs, defined below) or, in certain cases, the distributions are attributable to gain from the sale or exchange of a USRPI, as discussed below. If the requirements of clause (i) are met, the tax, reporting and withholding requirements applicable to U.S. persons generally will apply to the foreign shareholder and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation. If the requirements of clause (i) are not met, but the requirements of clause (ii) are met, such gains and distributions will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income tax treaty). Please see below for a discussion of the tax implications to foreign shareholders in the event that clause (iii) applies. With respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions to a foreign shareholder attributable to a Fund’s net short-term capital gain in excess of its net long-term capital loss and designated as such by the Fund in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year (“short-term capital gain dividends”) were generally not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax unless clause (i), (ii) or (iii) above applied to such distribution.

It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend the exemptions from withholding for interest-related dividends and short-term capital gain dividends with respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Even if permitted to do so, each Fund provides no assurance that it would designate any distributions as interest-related dividends or short-term capital gain dividends.

In the case of shares held through an intermediary, even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment, no assurance can be made that the intermediary will respect such a designation, and an intermediary may withhold even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment. Foreign shareholders should contact their intermediaries regarding the application of these rules to their accounts.

 

183


Table of Contents

 

Special rules apply to distributions to foreign shareholders from a Fund if it is either a “U.S. real property holding corporation” (USRPHC) or would be a USRPHC but for the operation of certain exceptions from USRPI treatment for interests in domestically controlled REITs or regulated investment companies and not-greater-than-5% interests in publicly traded classes of stock in REITs or regulated investment companies. Additionally, special rules apply to the sale of shares in a Fund if it is a USRPHC. Generally, a USRPHC is a domestic corporation that holds USRPIs — defined generally as any interest in U.S. real property or any equity interest in a USRPHC — the fair market value of which equals or exceeds 50% of the sum of the fair market values of the corporation’s USRPIs, interests in real property located outside the United States and other assets. If a Fund holds (directly or indirectly) significant interests in REITs, it may be a USRPHC.

If a Fund is a USRPHC or would be a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, amounts the Fund receives from REITs derived from gains realized from USRPIs generally will retain their character as such in the hands of the Fund’s foreign shareholders. In the hands of a foreign shareholder that holds (or has held in the prior 12 months) more than a 5% interest in any class of the Fund, such amounts generally will be treated as gains “effectively connected” with the conduct of a “U.S. trade or business,” and subject to tax at graduated rates. Moreover, such shareholder generally will be required to file a U.S. income tax return for the year recognized, and the Fund must withhold 35% of the amount of such distribution. Otherwise, in the case of all other foreign shareholders (i.e., those whose interest in any class of the Fund did not exceed 5% at any time during the prior 12 months), such amounts generally will be treated as ordinary income (regardless of any designation by the Fund that such distribution is a Capital Gain Dividend), and the Fund must withhold 30% (or a lower applicable treaty rate) of the amount of the distribution paid to such shareholders. If a Fund is subject to the rules of this paragraph, its foreign shareholders may also be subject to “wash sale” rules to prevent the avoidance of the foregoing tax-filing and payment obligations through the sale and repurchase of Fund shares. Prior to January 1, 2010, if a Fund was a USRPHC or would have been a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, similar rules generally also applied to any non-REIT USRPI gains recognized by the Fund directly or indirectly through certain lower-tier regulated investment companies. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend such application for distributions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be.

In addition, if a Fund is a USRPHC, it generally must withhold 10% of the amount realized in redemption by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder, and that shareholder must file a U.S. income tax return for the year of the disposition of the USRPI and pay any additional tax due on the gain. Prior to January 1, 2010, such withholding generally was not required with respect to amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund if it was a domestically controlled USRPHC, or, in certain limited cases, if the Fund (whether or not domestically controlled) held substantial investments in regulated investment companies that were domestically controlled USRPHCs. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this exemption from withholding for redemptions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Unless and until such legislation is enacted, beginning on January 1, 2010, withholding is required in respect of amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder if the Fund is a USRPHC, without regard to whether the Fund or any regulated investment company in which it invests is domestically controlled.

In order to qualify for any exemptions from withholding described above or for lower withholding tax rates under income tax treaties, or to establish an exemption from backup withholding, a foreign shareholder must comply with applicable certification requirements relating to its foreign status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN or substitute form). Foreign shareholders should consult their tax advisors in this regard.

Special rules (including withholding and reporting requirements) apply to foreign partnerships and those holding Fund shares through foreign partnerships. In addition, additional considerations may apply to foreign trusts and foreign estates. Investors holding Fund shares through foreign entities should consult their tax advisors about their particular situation.

 

184


Table of Contents

 

If a Fund qualifies and makes an election to pass through foreign taxes to its shareholders, as described earlier, foreign shareholders of the Fund generally will be subject to increased U.S. federal income taxation without a corresponding benefit for the pass-through of foreign taxes.

A beneficial holder of shares who is a foreign person may be subject to state and local tax and to the U.S. federal estate tax in addition to the U.S. federal income tax referred to above.

Tax-Exempt Shareholders

Under current law, a Fund serves to “block” (that is, prevent the attribution to shareholders of) UBTI from being realized by tax-exempt shareholders. Notwithstanding this “blocking” effect, a tax-exempt shareholder could realize UBTI by virtue of its investment in a Fund if shares in the Fund constitute debt-financed property in the hands of the tax-exempt shareholder within the meaning of Code Section 514(b).

It is possible that a tax-exempt shareholder will also recognize UBTI if a Fund recognizes excess inclusion income (as described above) derived from direct or indirect investments in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Furthermore, any investment in residual interests of a CMO that has elected to be treated as a REMIC can create complex tax consequences, especially if the Fund has state or local governments or other tax-exempt organizations as shareholders.

In addition, special tax consequences apply to charitable remainder trusts (CRTs) that invest in regulated investment companies that invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Under legislation enacted in December 2006, a CRT, as defined in Section 664 of the Code, that realizes UBTI for a taxable year must pay an excise tax annually of an amount equal to such UBTI. Under IRS guidance issued in October 2006, a CRT will not recognize UBTI solely as a result of investing in a Fund to the extent that it recognizes excess inclusion income. Rather, if at any time during any taxable year a CRT (or one of certain other tax-exempt shareholders, such as the United States, a state or political subdivision, or an agency or instrumentality thereof, and certain energy cooperatives) is a record holder of a share in a Fund and the Fund recognizes excess inclusion income, then the Fund will be subject to a tax on that portion of its excess inclusion income for the taxable year that is allocable to such shareholders at the highest U.S. federal corporate income tax rate. The extent to which the IRS guidance remains applicable in light of the December 2006 legislation is unclear. To the extent permitted under the 1940 Act, each Fund may elect to specially allocate any such tax to the applicable CRT, or other shareholder, and thus reduce such shareholder’s distributions for the year by the amount of the tax that relates to such shareholder’s interest in the Fund. Each Fund has not yet determined whether such an election will be made. CRTs are urged to consult their tax advisors concerning the consequences of investing in a Fund.

Shareholder Reporting Requirements Regarding Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts and Other Foreign Financial Assets

Effective for taxable years beginning after March 18, 2010, certain individuals (and, if provided in future guidance, certain domestic entities) must disclose annually their interests in “specified foreign financial assets” on their U.S. federal income tax returns. It is currently unclear under what circumstances, if any, a shareholder’s (indirect) interest in a Fund’s “specified foreign financial assets,” if any, falls within this requirement. In addition, shareholders that are U.S. persons and own, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of a Fund by vote or value could be required to report annually their “financial interest” in the Fund’s “foreign financial accounts,” if any, on Treasury Department Form TD F 90-22.1, Report of Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts (FBAR). Shareholders should consult a tax advisor regarding the applicability to them of both of these reporting requirements.

 

185


Table of Contents

 

Other Reporting and Withholding Requirements

New rules enacted in March 2010 require the reporting to the IRS of direct and indirect ownership of foreign financial accounts and foreign entities by U.S. persons. Failure, including by a U.S. person, to provide this required information can result in a 30% withholding tax on certain payments (“withholdable payments”) made after December 31, 2012. Withholdable payments include U.S.-source dividends and interest, and gross proceeds from the sale or other disposal of property that can produce U.S.-source dividends or interest.

The IRS has issued only limited guidance with respect to these new rules; their scope remains unclear and potentially subject to material change. Very generally, it appears that any distribution made by a Fund after December 31, 2012 (or such later date as may be provided in future guidance) to a shareholder, including a distribution in redemption of shares and a distribution of income or gains otherwise exempt from withholding under the rules applicable to non-U.S. shareholders described above (e.g., Capital Gain Dividends), will be subject to the new 30% withholding requirement. Payments to a foreign shareholder that is a “foreign financial institution” will generally be subject to withholding, unless such shareholder enters into an agreement with the IRS. Payments to shareholders that are U.S. persons or foreign individuals will generally not be subject to withholding, so long as such shareholders provide a Fund with such certifications or other documentation as the Fund requires to comply with the new rules. Persons investing in a Fund through an intermediary should contact their intermediary regarding the application of the new reporting and withholding regime to their investments in the Fund.

Shareholders are urged to consult a tax advisor regarding this new reporting and withholding regime, in light of their particular circumstances.

Tax Shelter Reporting Regulations

Under Treasury Regulations, if a shareholder recognizes a loss of $2 million or more for an individual shareholder or $10 million or more for a corporate shareholder, the shareholder must file with the IRS a disclosure statement on Form 8886. Direct shareholders of portfolio securities are in many cases excepted from this reporting requirement, but under current guidance, shareholders of a regulated investment company are not excepted. Future guidance may extend the current exception from this reporting requirement to shareholders of most or all regulated investment companies. The fact that a loss is reportable under these regulations does not affect the legal determination of whether the taxpayer’s treatment of the loss is proper. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors to determine the applicability of these regulations in light of their individual circumstances.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to Tax-Exempt Funds

If, at the close of each quarter of a regulated investment company’s taxable year, at least 50% of the value of its total assets consists of obligations the interest on which is exempt from U.S. federal income tax under Section 103(a) of the Code, then the regulated investment company may qualify to pay “exempt-interest dividends” and pass through to its shareholders the tax-exempt character of its income from such obligations. Tax-exempt funds intends to so qualify and are designed to provide shareholders with a high level of income in the form of exempt-interest dividends, which are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax.

Distributions of capital gains or income not attributable to interest on tax-exempt funds’ tax-exempt obligations will not constitute exempt-interest dividends and will be taxable to shareholders as described earlier.

Not later than 60 days after the close of a tax-exempt fund’s taxable year, the tax-exempt fund will notify its shareholders of the portion of the distributions for the taxable year which constitutes exempt-interest dividends. In general, if an amount of the tax-exempt fund’s distribution designated as an exempt-interest dividend exceeds the fund’s net-exempt interest, the amount so qualifying as tax-exempt will be scaled back ratably to the amount of its net-exempt income. In such a case, each tax-exempt fund shareholder must proportionately reduce the

 

186


Table of Contents

amount of the dividend it treats as tax-exempt, and will generally include the excess income as a taxable dividend to the extent of certain disallowed deductions and thereafter as a return of capital. The deductibility of interest paid or accrued on indebtedness incurred by a shareholder to purchase or carry shares of a tax-exempt fund may be limited. The portion of such interest that is non-deductible generally equals the amount of such interest times the ratio of a tax-exempt fund’s exempt-interest dividends received by the shareholder to all of the tax-exempt fund’s dividends received by the shareholder (excluding Capital Gain Dividends and any capital gains required to be included in the shareholder’s long term capital gains in respect of capital gains retained by the tax-exempt fund, as described earlier).

Although exempt-interest dividends are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax, there may not be a similar exemption under the laws of a particular state or local taxing jurisdiction. Thus, exempt-interest dividends may be subject to state and local taxes; however, tax-exempt funds invests at least 80% of its net assets in municipal bonds that pay interest that is exempt not only from U.S. federal income tax, but also from the applicable state’s personal income tax (but not necessarily local taxes or taxes of other states). You should consult your tax advisor to discuss the tax consequences of your investment in a tax-exempt fund.

Tax-exempt interest on certain “private activity bonds” has been designated as a “tax preference item” and must be added back to taxable income for purposes of calculating U.S. federal alternative minimum tax (AMT). To the extent that a tax-exempt fund invests in certain private activity bonds, its shareholders will be required to report that portion of a tax-exempt fund’s distributions attributable to income from the bonds as a tax preference item in determining their U.S. federal AMT, if any. Shareholders will be notified of the tax status of distributions made by a tax-exempt fund. Persons who may be “substantial users” (or “related persons” of substantial users) of facilities financed by private activity bonds should consult their tax advisors before purchasing shares in a tax-exempt fund. In addition, exempt-interest dividends paid by a tax-exempt fund to a corporate shareholder are, with very limited exceptions, included in the shareholder’s “adjusted current earnings” as part of its U.S. federal AMT calculation. As of the date of this SAI, individuals are subject to the U.S. federal AMT at a maximum rate of 28% and corporations at a maximum rate of 20%. Shareholders with questions or concerns about the U.S. federal AMT should consult their own tax advisors.

Ordinarily, a tax-exempt fund relies on an opinion from the issuer’s bond counsel that interest on the issuer’s obligation will be exempt from U.S. federal income taxation. However, no assurance can be given that the IRS will not successfully challenge such exemption, which could cause interest on the obligation to be taxable and could jeopardize a tax-exempt fund’s ability to pay exempt-interest dividends. Similar challenges may occur as to state-specific exemptions. Also, from time to time legislation may be introduced or litigation may arise that would change the treatment of exempt-interest dividends. Such litigation or legislation may have the effect of raising the state or other taxes payable by shareholders on such dividends. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors for the current law on exempt-interest dividends.

A shareholder who receives Social Security or railroad retirement benefits should consult his or her tax advisor to determine what effect, if any, an investment in a tax-exempt fund may have on the federal taxation of such benefits. Exempt-interest dividends are included in income for purposes of determining the amount of benefits that are taxable.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

If, at the close of each quarter of its taxable year, at least 50% of the value of the total assets of a regulated investment company consists of obligations, which, when held by an individual, the interest therefrom is exempt from income taxation by California (California Exempt Securities), then the regulated investment company will be qualified to make distributions that are exempt from California state individual income tax (California exempt-interest distributions). For this purpose, California Exempt Securities generally are limited to California municipal securities and certain U.S. Government and U.S. Possession obligations. The California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund intends to qualify under the above requirements so that it can pay California exempt-interest distributions.

 

187


Table of Contents

 

Within sixty days after the close of its taxable year, the Fund will notify its shareholders of the portion of the distributions paid by the Fund that is exempt from California state individual income tax. The total amount of California exempt-interest distributions paid by the Fund with respect to any taxable year cannot exceed the excess of the amount of interest received by the Fund for such year on California Exempt Securities over any amounts that, if the Fund were treated as an individual, would be considered expenses related to tax exempt income or amortizable bond premium that would not be deductible under federal income or California state individual income tax law.

Interest on indebtedness incurred or continued by a shareholder in a taxable year to purchase or carry shares of the California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund is not deductible for California state individual income tax purposes if the Fund distributes California exempt-interest distributions during the shareholder’s taxable year.

The foregoing is only a summary of some of the important California state individual income tax considerations generally affecting the California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund and its shareholders. No attempt is made to present a detailed explanation of the California state income tax treatment of the Fund or its shareholders, and this discussion is not intended as a substitute for careful planning. Further, it should be noted that the portion of any of the Fund’s distributions constituting California exempt-interest distributions is excludable from income for California state individual income tax purposes only. Any distributions paid to shareholders subject to California state franchise tax or California state corporate income tax may be taxable for such purposes. Accordingly, potential investors in the Fund, including, in particular, corporate investors which may be subject to either California franchise tax or California corporate income tax, should consult their own tax advisors with respect to the application of such taxes to the receipt of the Fund’s distributions and as to their own California state tax situation, in general.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the Fund’s exempt-interest distributions paid to residents of Georgia attributable to interest received by the Georgia Funds on tax-exempt obligations of the State of Georgia or its political subdivision or authorities and other Fund distributions attributable to interest received from U.S. Government obligations will be exempt from Georgia individual and corporate income taxes. There is no Georgia intangibles tax or other personal property tax applicable to the shares of the Georgia Funds owned by investors residing in Georgia. The Georgia intangibles tax was repealed by the Georgia General Assembly on March 21, 1996, further ratified by a Constitutional Amendment approved in the November 1996 General Election (GA. L 1996, P.130 § 9). The Georgia intangibles tax was repealed for taxable years beginning after January 1, 1996. Distributions attributable to capital gains realized from the sale of Georgia municipal bonds and U.S. Government obligations will be subject to the State of Georgia short-term or long-term capital gains tax, which follow the federal income tax treatment. Interest received by a Georgia resident from non-Georgia municipal state bonds and distributions received from mutual funds that derive income from non-Georgia municipal or state bonds will be subject to Georgia income tax.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s exempt-interest distributions attributable to interest received by the Fund on tax-exempt obligations of the state of Maryland or its political subdivisions or authorities, or obligations issued by the government of Puerto Rico, the U.S. Virgin Islands, Guam, American Samoa or their authorities (Maryland Municipal Bonds) and distributions attributable to gains from the disposition Maryland Municipal Bonds (other than obligations issued by U.S. possessions) or interest on U.S. Government obligations will be exempt from Maryland individual and corporate income taxes; any other Fund distributions will be subject to Maryland income tax. Fund shareholders will be informed annually regarding the portion of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s distributions that constitutes income exempt from Maryland income taxes. Maryland presently includes in Maryland taxable income a portion of certain items of tax preference as defined in the Code. Interest paid on certain private activity bonds constitutes such a tax

 

188


Table of Contents

preference if the bonds (i) are not Maryland Municipal Bonds or (ii) are Maryland Municipal Bonds issued by U.S. possessions. Accordingly, up to 50% of any distributions from the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund attributable to interest on such private activity bonds may not be exempt from Maryland state and local individual income taxes. Shares of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund will not be subject to the Maryland personal property tax.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s exempt-interest distributions attributable to interest received by the Fund on tax-exempt obligations of the State of North Carolina or its political subdivisions, commissions, authorities, agencies or non-profit educational institutions organized or chartered under the laws of North Carolina, or obligations issued by the United States or its possessions will be exempt from North Carolina individual and corporate income taxes. Although capital gain distributions generally are subject to tax in North Carolina, individual shareholders of the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund may deduct the amount of capital gain distributions (if any) attributable to the sale of certain obligations issued before July 1, 1995 for purposes of determining their North Carolina taxable income.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s exempt-interest distributions attributable to interest received by the Fund on tax-exempt obligations of the State of South Carolina, its political subdivisions or exempt interest upon obligations of the United States will be exempt from South Carolina income taxes. Distributions of capital gains or income not attributable to interest from tax-exempt obligations of the State of South Carolina, its political subdivisions or exempt interest on obligations of the United States may be subject to South Carolina income taxes.

Although distributions of capital gains and the gain recognized with respect to the sale or exchange of shares of the Fund may be subject to the South Carolina state income tax, individuals, estates and trusts are entitled to a deduction for South Carolina taxable income purposes equal to 44% of the net capital gain recognized in South Carolina during a taxable year. The definition of net capital gain for federal income tax purposes is utilized for purposes of this deduction. In the case of estates or trusts, the deduction is applicable only to income taxed to the estate or trust or individual beneficiaries and not income passed through to non-individual beneficiaries.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to the Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

The portion of the Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s distributions attributable to interest on (i) debt obligations of Virginia or its political subdivisions, and (ii) debt obligations of the United States and any authority, commission or instrumentality of the United States (including Puerto Rico, Guam, and the U.S. Virgin Islands), that are, in each case, backed by the full faith and credit of the borrowing government, will be exempt from Virginia income tax. Furthermore, any of the Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s distributions that are attributable to realized gains from dispositions of the foregoing debt obligations may also be exempt from Virginia income tax.

 

189


Table of Contents

 

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

As of August 31, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “principal holder “(i.e., owns of record or is known by the Trust to own beneficially 5% or more of any class of a Fund’s outstanding shares) is listed below.

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending February 28:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,676,047.3070    53.15%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   539,148.0880    46.01%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   726,305.3420    49.22%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FLR.

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   88,552.6660    6.00%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,573,901.9350    59.74%

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN: JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   796,922.2030    7.24%

 

190


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN: JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   649,976.3610    5.91%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   551,871.7790    21.75%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   174,179.6740    6.86%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   123,752.4100    18.70%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   174,179.6740    6.86%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FLR.

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   54,949.4480    8.30%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class B

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

   38,546.0020    5.82%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   850,692.7110    29.03%

 

191


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FLR.

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   284,293.1510    9.70%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   808,790.6280    55.02%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   347,662.9250    23.65%

Columbia Global Value Fund

Class Z

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

ASSOCIATES IN DIAGNOSTIC RADIOLOGY

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   93,358.6250    6.35%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   5,157,701.7550    18.42%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL RETIREMENT INS & ANN CO

FBO VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

200 WOOD AVE S

ISELIN NJ 08830-2769

   2,693,711.8980    9.62%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT

FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO, CA 94104-4151

   2,562,039.2280    9.15%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   22,515,7400    19.90%

 

192


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia International Value Fund

Class B

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   5,766.2090    5.10%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,227,586.1220    27.38%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   384,709.7330    8.58%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   34,350,727.8690    39.52%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS 101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   18,665,218.9790    21.47%

Columbia International Value Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   7,422,644.5780    8.54%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,591,092.9160    69.20%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   72,603.6910    44.54%

 

193


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   59,048.1100    28.82%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   30,086.1110    14.68%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   51,769,526.9970    62.63%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT ADVISOR

COLUMBIA GROWTH ASST ALLOC-NY529

ATTN: JIM MARIN 3RD FL

245 SUMMER ST

BOSTON MA 02210-1133

   4,566,619.7210    5.52%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   441,376.6610    43.79%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class R

  

CHRISTI LAIRD FBO

COUNTRYWIDE MECHANICAL SYSTEMS

401K PROFIT SHARING PLAN & TRUST INC

9330 STEVENS RD STE A

SANTEE CA 92071-5639

   3,993.0390    42.27%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class R

  

NFS LLC CUST

HUNTINGTON NATIONAL BANK

FBO: EB ACCOUNTS

7 EASTON OVAL

COLUMBUS OH 43219-6010

   3,140.5300    33.25%

 

194


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

APPLIED RELIABILITY ENGINEERING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   2,173.7330    23.01%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,867,095.5940    99.96%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   32,562.941.9940    88.33%

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,032,605.2870    5.51%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   1,883,865.3490    13.15%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

RELIANCE TRUST CO FBO

RETIREMENT PLANS SERVICED BY METLIFE

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   1,384,510.8550    9.67%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY LLC TTEE

FBO CLIENTS BENEFITS CLIENTS

401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   802,853.0910    5.60%

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,368.6480    5.43%

 

195


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

NFS/FMTC ROLLOVER IRA

FBO GENE P ALVES

560 RAY ST

FALL RIVER MA 02720-7208

   7,847.3670      5.09%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   28,122,739.8040      25.35%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   18,508,025.9610      16.68%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) FOR LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   14,756,633.7260      13.30%   

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TRANSFERRED SAVINGS CUST FBO BANK OF AMERICA N.A

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   5,948,594.3730      5.36%   

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,303,603.5440      14.22

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   436,675.1230      7.89

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   585,984.5170      17.12

 

196


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

MICHAEL MIRE FBO

GULFSTREAM SERVICES INC 401K PSP & TRUST

103 DICKSON RD

HOUMA LA 70363-7306

   82,420.9220      78.32

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

COMMUNITY BANK NA AS CUST

FBO SIMED 1165(E) RETIREMENT PLAN

6 RHOADS DR STE 7

UTICA NY 13502-6317

   19,418.2520      18.45

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,109,406.6510      99.89

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   41,482,188.4480      34.60

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN: NORMA AJA

P.O. BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   18,275,848.6640      15.24

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   13,376,089.4290      11.16%   

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   11,199,371.5990      7.70%   

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MNGT SVC

FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

ATTN PRUCHOICE UNTI

194 WOOD AVE S

ISELIN NJ 08830-2710

   7,408,061.1970      5.10%   

 

197


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,623,892.5810    17.14%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   904,907.5070    9.55%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,932,724.7210    26.51%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   6,482,084.5310    12.33%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   2,697,499.8120    5.13%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   353,713.0210    10.76%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   13,447,698.8280    16.00%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   10,040,499.7850    11.95%

 

198


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMER

4800 DEER LAKE DR E

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,446,356.2090    10.05%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

   6,869,310.5170    8.17%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-415

   6,773,805.6020    8.06%

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Class Z

  

FIDELITY INVESTMENTS INST L OPS CO

FIIOC AS AGENT FOR CERTAIN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

100 MAGELLAN WAY

COVINGTON KY 41015-1999

   6,751,574.6710    8.03%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MNGT SVC

FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

ATTN: PROCHOICE UNIT

194 WOOD AVE S

ISELIN NJ 08830-2710

   15,967,435.7510    21.28%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,736,281.8880    11.64%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,345,070.0140    48.70%

 

199


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,275,537.7720    53.82%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   1,209,057.3920    7.86%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   9,804,286.9370    19.67%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,293,123.4110    12.63%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

4800 DEER LAKE DR E

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   4,372,982.4200    8.77%

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-415

   4,053,356.7700    8.13%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class A

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,467.7520    52.68%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

WILLIAM C LIVINGSTON

BRONAH M LIVINGSTON

4254 RUSTLING WOODS DR

DENVER NC 28037-5463

   13,003.8390    5.46%

 

200


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class C

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,000.0000    66.31%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,730.8890    7.28%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class R

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,246.4790    99.59%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class Z

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   125,689.4900    86.03%

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA IRA

CHARLES J HOWELL

600 UNIVERSITY ST STE 1725

SEATTLE WA 98101-4120

   16,738.2680    11.46%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   9,616,817.1710    16.34%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY
SMITH BARNEY

HARBOSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   4,907,913.3890    8.34%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class A

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   3,347,885.8880    5.69%

 

201


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,121,699.8620    44.24%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   182,046.8070    7.18%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   12,100,883.2820    53.69%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   1,801,294.0250    7.99%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2I, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   1,300,891.0260    5.77%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD CT 06104-2999

   404,351.1090    44.63%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   67,289.3190    7.43%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   24,433,604.5490    25.46%

 

202


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   17,430,361.2730    18.17%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

   9,804,031.1820    10.22%

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACOUNT

FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   7,570,908.3860    7.89%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,493,803.5100    10.55%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   403,891.6150    26.24%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   139,719.1580    9.08%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   797,783.6690    19.90%

 

203


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   522,218.4880    13.03%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   227,244.8610    5.67%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

ORCHARD TRUST CO TTEE

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401K

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   47,994.4000    15.33%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

DEARBORN MID WEST CONVEYOR CO 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   46,382.8210    14.82%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

NTC & CO

CUST BODE CALL & STROUPE

FBO BODE CALL & STROUPE

P.O. BOX 173859

DENVER CO 80217-3859

   32,856.3270    10.49%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   22,172.4570    7.08%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD CT 06104-2999

   17,859.8770    5.70%

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class R

  

GPC SECURITIES INC AGENT FOR RELIANCE TRUST COMPANY FBO

WHITEMAN LUMBER COMPANY 401K PLAN

P.O. BOX 79377

ATLANTA GA 30357-7377

   16,562.9740    5.29%

 

204


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   54,208,961.1110      61.99%   

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class Z

  

VANGUARD FIDUCIARY TRUST COMPANY NATIONS FUNDS

P.O. BOX 2600 VM 613

ATTN OUTSIDE FUNDS

VALLEY FORGE PA 19482-2600

   8,110,560.1520      9.27%   

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Class Z

  

TEXAS CHILDREN’S HOSPITAL FOUNDATION

1919 S.BRAESWOOD

HOUSTON TX 77030-4412

   6,027,850.6560      6.89%   

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

NEW YORK LIFE TRUST COMPANY

690 CANTON ST STE 100

WESTWOOD MA 02090-2324

   3,380,978.2100      16.08

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

PIMS/PRUDENTIAL RETIREMENT

AS NOMINEE FOR THE TTEE/CUST

MAGELLAN HEALTH SERVICE INC

6950 COLUMBIA GATEWAY DR

COLUMBIA MD 21046-2706

   1,349,770.7930      6.42

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY
LL TTEE

FBO EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   1,224,647.4640      5.82

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

JPMORGAN CHASE TRUSTEE CUST

FBO ERICSSON CAPITAL ACCUMULATION AND SAVINGS PLAN

93 WARD PKWY

KANSAS CITY MO 64114-3317

   1,093,460.0330      5.20

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   68,401,274.4280      35.19

 

205


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   42,191,802.7500      21.70

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) FOR LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   25,762,004.0100      13.25

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,435,760.4780      6.29

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class A

  

ING LIFE INSURANCE & ANNUITY CO

ING FUND OPERATIONS

1 ORANGE WAY

WINDSOR CT 06095-4773

   6,528,034.4580      5.52

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   268,576.0030      6.18

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   239,097.0000      5.50

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,036,617.8700      21.09

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   1,340,383.1390      9.31

 

206


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

GREAT WEST LIFE & ANNUITY

C/O FASCORE LLC

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   15,502,397.4310      61.70

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD, CT 06104-2999

   1,534,665.8730      6.11

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Y

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   1,138.9930      100.00

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   41,442,903.6130      19.47

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   31,705,425.6820      14.89

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY ST

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   18,626,637.9240      8.75

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   18,364,780.9080      8.63

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   554,599.2450      26.38

 

207


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   35,532.3860      42.61

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   49,487.8760      39.83

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class C

  

SUMMERVILLE PEDIACTRICS PA

PROFIT SHARING PLAN

312 MIDLAND PARKWAY

SUMMERVILLE SC 29485-8102

   9,433.2020      7.59

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   7,629.9760      6.14

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

GPC SECURITIES INC AGENT FOR RELIANCE TRUST COMPANY FBO

VIRGINIA LAB SUPPLY 401K PSP

PO BOX 79377

ATLANTA GA 30357-7377

   11,0726210      50.08

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   5,494.4590      24.85

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

APPLIED RELIABILITY ENGINEERING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   2,132.3010      9.65

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

MIRAMAR LABS 401K PROFIT-SHARING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   2,075.4350      9.39

 

208


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   65,820,152.9370      57.36

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   16,342,850.5470      14.24

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT ADVISORS INC FBO COLUMBIA MASTERS INTERNATIONAL EQUITY PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM MARIN

ONE FINANCIAL CENTER FL 3

BOSTON MA 02111-2694

   8,298,492.9220      7.23

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Class Z

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

   1,088,418.8280      100.00

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,208,893.4990      17.25

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   79,205.3320      29.66

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   81,238.5560      30.31

 

209


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN: PETER BOOTH, 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   19,678.8020      7.34

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   12,402,334.2720      59.82

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Class Z

  

GPC SECURITIES INC AGENT FOR RELIANCE TRUST COMPANY FBO

PLEXUS CORP. 401(K) SAVINGS PLAN

P.O. BOX 79377

ATLANTA GA 30357-7377

   1,435,274.1330      6.92

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT

FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   757,484.0330      8.95

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   624,406.6530      7.37

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY LLC TTEE

FBO EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   546,792.3390      6.46

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

NEW YORK LIFE TRUST COMPANY

690 CANTON ST STE 100

WESTWOOD MA 02090-2344

   493,365.5470      5.83

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class A

  

FIFTH THIRD BANK TTEE

FBO VARIOUS FASCORE LL RECORDKEPT

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   455,118.2040      5.38%   

 

210


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   30,722,153.5870    33.60%

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA TTEE

BANK OF AMERICA 401K PLAN

ATTN: NORMA AJA

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   18,829,065.7420    20.59%

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA TTEE

401(K) FOR LEGACY FLEET TRUST

PO BOX 1939

HOUSTON TX 77251-1939

   9,275,354.8020    10.14%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,440,867.1760    8.49%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class A

  

SUPPLEMENTAL INCOME TRUST FUND

P.O. BOX 8338

BOSTON MA 02266-8338

   2,428,315.2810    5.99%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   29,982.8160    11.96%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   423,829.9170    22.45%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   106,397.2450    5.64%

 

211


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

HARTFORD LIFE INS. CO.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT

ATTN UIT OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 2999

HARTFORD CT 06104-2999

   585,318.4600    27.98%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   134,873.3930    6.45%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

DCGT TRUSTEE & OR CUSTODIAN

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED PRIN ADVTG OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH ST

DES MOINES IA 50392-0001

   110,452.0530    5.28%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class R

  

FIFTH THIRD BANK TRUSTEE FBO

VARIOUS FASCORP RECORDKEPT PLANS

C/O FASCORP

8515 ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

   106,948.3090    5.11%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,440,556.3770    15.58%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   12,133,939.7780    14.06%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   12,022,382.9750    13.93%

 

212


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

FIDELITY INVESTMENTS INST L OPS CO

FIIOC AS AGENT FOR CERTAIN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

100 MAGELLAN WAY

COVINGTON KY 41015-1999

   6,938,111.8800    8.04%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   5,423,694.2660    6.29%

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

   4,800,292.2420    5.56%

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,488,370.7030      75.67

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   43.393.8240      61.67

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC. FBO

BARBARA PHILLIPS

933 111TH AVE NE APT 532

BELLEVUE WA 98004-8544

   11,416.4560      26.76

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   6,707.4070      15.72

 

213


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   4,001.9850      9.38

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC. FBO

RAYDEAN RANDLETT

TRADITIONAL IRA

1135 HIDDEN OAKS DR

MENLO PARK CA 94025-6042

   2,679.5480      6.28

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class C

  

AMERICAN ENTERPRISE INVESTMENT SVCS

P.O. BOX 9446

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55440-9446

   2,444.9880      5.73

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,095,457.0520      99.53

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   594,993.7540      48.17

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC. FBO

THELMA STEWART MANAGEMENT

COMPANY, LLC

3031 W MARCH LN STE 123

STOCKTON CA 95219-6567

   192,667.5230      15.60

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   21,665.8350      96.98

 

214


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   151,043.7160      74.34

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

EXEMPTION TR CREATED UNDER 2004 SICHI FAM TRUST TR

2555 TODD CT

ARCATA CA 95521-5147

   17,771.9890      8.75

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   20,402,583.1980      91.11

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   500,329.0080      28.54

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

   236,234.9350      13.47

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund-

Class A

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   119,832.3740      6.83

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   34,565.4740      49.17

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   7,603.0950      10.82

 

215


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

STEVE G LYMAN & ALIDA B LYMAN

4492 HAVERSTRAW DRIVE

DUNWOODY GA 30338-6604

   5,352.1450      7.61

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

DAVID G HUNTER

4698 JERFFERSON TOWNSHIP LN

MARIETTA GA 30066-3826

   5,236.5320      7.45

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund-

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

WILSON S MOBLEY

2058 BRIAN WAY

DECATUR GA 30033-3826

   4,696.6730      6.68

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

   4,633.4730      6.59

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   91,354.3690      25.97

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

RUTH LAUTZ TR

RUTH LAUTZ TTEE

3315 PEACHTREE INDUSTRIAL BLVD

DECATUR GA 30033-3826

   23,749.9060      6.75

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   9,169,349.1900      95.51

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,761,279.4370      24.05

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

TRANSAMERICA LIFE INS COMPANY

1150 S OLIVE ST STE 2700

LOS ANGELES CA 90015-2211

   2,611,942.2490      16.70

 

216


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia High Income Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

TRANSAMERICA
FINANCIAL LIFE

1150 S OLIVE ST STE 2700

LOS ANGELES, CA 90015-2211

   851,362.5680      5.44

Columbia High Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,400,615.9210      44.23

Columbia High Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,132,847.9740      39.16

Columbia High Income Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL
MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   176,673.0810      6.11

Columbia High Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   53,986,303.5250      68.78

Columbia High Income Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   4,946,724.2400      6.30

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   10,224,400.9780      41.92

 

217


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,458,714.4550      48.57

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   3,766,178.7790      45.77

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   98,224.7790      44.29

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

BROWN & JONES REPORTING 401K PLAN

PO BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   29,283.8680      13.20

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MATC FBO

V RAO EMANDI M D

401K PSP & TRUST

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

   17,074.9380      7.70

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

ALBERT FREI & SONS INC

401K PLAN

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   12,602.1910      5.68

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

JOSEPH D POLK FBO

VANTAGE SYSTEMS INC

401K PSP & TRUST

4600 FORBES BLVD STE 250

LANHAM MD 20706-4359

   12,156.0160      5.48

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,996,804.0880      41.68

 

218


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia LifeGoal®

Balanced Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,829,657.0880      38.19

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   7,640,599.3170      45.11

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   4,280,791.5270      50.89

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,701,596.4930      39.75

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   53,618.6240      30.15

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

RIVERFRONT STEEL 401K PLAN

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   25,358.8900      14.26

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

CLINICA CAMPESINA FAMILY HEALTH SER

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   23,993.0390      13.49

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

BROWN & JONES REPORTING 401K PLAN

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   18,004.5740      10.12

 

219


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class
 

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

ALBERT FREI & SONS INC 401K PLAN

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   10,211.8830      5.74

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,165,077.3580      52.07

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,015,604.8400      24.42

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   419,856.2380      10.10

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,178,076.5960      37.90

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,862,336.8520      54.65

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   994,475.6320      42.97%   

 

220


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

O DANIEL AUTOMOTIVE GROUP 401K SA

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   32,943.8470    52.59%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

GROSSMONT FAMILY MEDICAL GROUP 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

   3,540.0850    5.65%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

MIRAMAR LABS 401K PROFIT-SHARING

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

   5,874.0900    9.38%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

TRI-EAGLE SALES 401K PROFIT SHARING

PO BOX 10758

FARGO, ND 58106-0758

   7,257.2510    11.59%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   610,709.0520    29.68%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   582,540.4770    28.31%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth

Portfolio

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

   164,256.6900    7.98%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   463,712.1810    33.18%

 

221


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   271,383.8400    43.10%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   174,454.9530    35.56%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   126,661.8280    43.65%

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   34,134.5560    11.76%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

ROBERT GLADSTONE

LESLIE GLADSTONE

2468 BELMONT RD NW

WASHINGTON DC 20008-1610

   358,822.2860    13.95%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   220,932.6060    8.59%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

MARK & MARY ANN RONALD TRUST

MARK & MARY ANN RONALD TTEES

7110 44TH ST

CHEVY CHASE MD 20815-6039

   132,477.3530    5.15%

 

222


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   9,001.3210    15.06%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

MARY A MICHELS

1658 HARDWICK RD

BALTIMORE MD 21286-8128

   5,894.5610    9.86%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

RALPH M VITALE SR

AUDREY J VITALE

3510 E JOPPA RD

BALTIMORE MD 21234-3313

   5,224.3900    8.74%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

ROBERT F ROHR & BARBARA M ROHR JT TEN

608 CHURCHILL RD

BEL AIR MD 21014-4245

   4,725.1010    7.91%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLERING LLC

2801 MARKET ST

SAINT LOUIS MO 63103-2523

   4,665.7530    7.81%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

   3,648.1450    6.10%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL

MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   3,596.6430    6.02%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   94,172.8150    22.35%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   88,159.2190    20.92%

 

223


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   11,376,071.5190    94.19%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   705,689.8330    12.28%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   115,823.5380    26.65%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   287,199.0170    24.11%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2. 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY, NJ 07311

   88,938.8090    7.47%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,664.9660    56.99%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MATC FBO

PROST DATA INC 401K

PSP & TRUST

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

   399,5780    13.68%

 

224


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

BRETT PEAKS FBO

LENOX VILLAGE DENTISTRY 401K PSP & TRUST

6905 LENOX VILLAGE DR

NASHVILLE TN 37211-7172

   386.9590    13.24%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MID ATLANTIC TRUST CO FBO

SAL OPPENHEIM JR & CIE 401K PSP & TRUST

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

   288.0130    9.86%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,650,697.2390    91.02%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT SERVICES LLC FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

100 MULBERRY ST

NEWARK NJ 07102-4056

   297,829.2580    8.26%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

MAURICIO CASTILLO TTEE

MAURICIO CASTILLO LIVING TRUST

416 HILLSBOROUGH ST

CHAPEL HILL NC 27514-3102

   278,666.2040    7.73%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING, LLC

FRANK M DRENDEL

P.O. BOX 9212

HICKORY NC 28603-9212

   208,354.4670    5.78%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

FLOYD L & RAMONA

M MORRIS TR

FLOYD L MORRIS

3136 OLD LOWGAP RD

LOWGAP NC 27024-7416

   19,008.7090    16.32%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

RBS CAPITAL MARKETS CORP FBO

EDWARD SANDERS

DOUGLAS J SANDERS

JT TEN/WROS

2218 RICHARDSON DR

CHARLOTTE NC 28211-3265

   14,212.1620    12.20%

 

225


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

LILLIAN G SHOAF

830 METAIRIE LN

WINSTON SALEM NC 27104-3319

   9,747.6860    8.37%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

JASON LAMBERTH

CAROL LAMBERTH

PO BOX 24

STATESVILLE NC 28687-0024

   8,275.3300    7.10%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

101 MONTGOMERY ST

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94101-4151

   8,231.0200    7.07%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

KATE R HOOTS

1372 HARRIS AVE

NEWTON CA 28658-1611

   6,643.0310    5.70%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

CAROL LEE SMITH WOOD

P.O. BOX 313

HAW RIVER NC 27258-0313

   6,222.4570    5.34%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   145,918.7080    34.01%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

NFS LLC FEBO

CREIGHTON W SOSSOMON

BANK OF AMERICA COLLATERAL

P.O. BOX 9

HIGHLANDS NC 28741-0009

   28,307.1610    6.60%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   15,372,334.8690    91.85%

 

226


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   5,600,044.3410    18.66%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   160,515.4320    18.20%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   4,926,570.2190    38.23%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL

MARKETS, INC

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   890,814.6430    6.91%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   1,894,327.6870    89.35%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class Y

  

CLISE PROPERTIES INC

1700 7TH AVE STE 1800

SEATTLE WA 98101-1312

   224,803.2240    10.60%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   145,294,168.8900    71.57%

 

227


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   10,051,809.7010    25.24%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY & CO

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA II, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   4,676,412.5930    11.74%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund-

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   6,954,9570    21.65%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

KEVIN W BARR

FRANCINE BARR

5235 DRYSTACK LN

GLEN ALLEN VA 23059-2532

   4,906.4600    15.27%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

DARRELL C REED

MAUREEN O REED

4681 SHELBURNE RD

RADFORD VA 24141-8057

   4,609.1020    14.35%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

SIDNEY MORRIS

3605 BERMUDA RUN DR

VALDOSTA GA 31605-1082

   3,505.4160    10.91%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   2,368,911.6830    47.51%

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

HOUSE ACCOUNT

ATTN PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

   258,752.2480    5.19%

 

228


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia Short Term

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   159,654,192.8970    86.25%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   775,103.7670    32.40%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

INTERNET RESOURCE MANAGEMENT

BANK OF AMERICA NA COLLATERAL

P.O. BOX 1329

FORT MILL SC 29716-1329

   541,187.7690    22.63%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   58,892.8520    60.68%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

   6,618.2480    6.82%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

SUE B JAMES EST TX SHEL TRUST

1129 WATERFRONT DR

MT PLEASANT SC 29464-7428

   5,355.4450    5.52%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

WELLS FARGO BANK NA FBO

HOPKINS M CRTA

P.O. BOX 1533

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55480-1533

   5,203.0760    5.36%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

   5,040.7010    5.19%

 

229


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   367,785.4010    38.59%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

RAYMOND JAMES & ASSOC INC

FBO ANNIE LEE FAYSSOUX TTEE

203 PACOLET HWY

GAFFNEY SC 29340-2816

   72,740.5460    7.63%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   12,681,570.0070    89.93%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   575,686.5780    26.27%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   86,466.3060    24.94%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   292,987.2470    51.76%

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   86,875,990.2020    79.37%

 

230


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance    Percentage
of Class

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

C HENRY JONES TTEE

C HENRY JONES REVOCLIVTRUST

7320 COLONY POINT RD

NORFOLK VA 23505-3300

   235,505.2150    5.11%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   13,795.6150    14.62%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

EDWARD P HAZARD JR

FRANCES H HAZARD

915 HOLLYWOOD DR

CHESAPEAKE VA 23320-4821

   8,324.7130    8.82%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

PETER BRUNK & DIANE BRUNK JT WROS

3501 CARDINAL LN

PORTSMOUTH VA 23703-3631

   7,391.2080    7.83%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

FIRST CLEARING CORPORATION

MARTHA W STEERS TTEE

MARTHA W STEERS LIVING TRUST

5801 WILLIAMSBURG

LANDING DR

WILLIAMSBURG VA 23185-3778

   6,783.3320    7.19%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class B

  

NFS LLC FEBO

NORMA F STUART

6809 DARBY LN

SPRINGFIELD VA 22150-2006

   5,537.5620    5.87%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   53,516.4800    17.68%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   23,109,999.8350    92.99%

 

231


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Class

Corporate Bond Portfolio

Class A

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,030,991.0000    99.24%

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Class A

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN: BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   3,673,814.0810    86.12%

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio

Class A

  

STATE STREET BANK &

TRUST CO

AAF LIFEGOAL INCOME & GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

   430,028.9370    10.08%

As of August 31, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “control person” (as that term is defined in the 1940 Act) of a Fund because it owns of record more than 25% of the outstanding shares of the Fund by virtue of its fiduciary roles with respect to its clients or otherwise, is shown below. A control person may be able to facilitate shareholder approval of proposals it approves and to impede shareholder approval of proposals it opposes. If a control person’s record ownership of a Fund’s outstanding shares exceeds 50%, then, for certain shareholder proposals, such control person may be able to approve, or prevent approval, of such proposals without regard to votes by other Fund shareholders.

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending February 28:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Fund

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   8,941,500.7370    31.83%

Columbia International Value Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   34,350,727.8690    28.74%

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   51,769,526.9970    55.08%

 

232


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
     Percentage
of Fund
 

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core

Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     35,430,037.5880         86.95%   

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     501,403.7210         71.78

Columbia Marsico International

Opportunities Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     54,208,961.1110         50.44

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     68,401,274.4280         31.75

Columbia Multi-Advisor International

Equity Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     65,820,152.9370         56.22

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     1,088,418.8280         100.00

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     12,402,334.2720         36.40

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     30,772,153.5870         30.75

 

233


Table of Contents

 

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
     Percentage
of Fund
 

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     2,538,471.9340         56.38

Columbia CA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     20,402,583.1980         85.53

Columbia GA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     9,169,349.1900         77.87%   

Columbia High Income Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     53,986,303.5250         53.88%   

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth

Portfolio

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     23,278,951.3000         43.93%   

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     15,638,592.1770         42.86%   
Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio   

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     5,645,598.1320         41.54%   

 

234


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Fund

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

  

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INC FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN: SERVICE TEAM

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 3

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

   1,036.212.8020    36.90%

Columbia MD Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   11,376,071.5190    75.19%

Columbia Masters International

Equity Portfolio

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   6,650,697.2390    45.30%

Columbia NC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   15,372,334.8690    73.61%

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   147,188,496.5770    59.13%

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond

Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   159,654,192.8970    69.43%

Columbia SC Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,681,570.0070    72.28%

 

235


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share
Balance
   Percentage
of Fund

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS, TX 75202-3908

   86,875,990.2020    77.18%

Columbia VA Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   23,109,999.8350    77.39%

Corporate Bond Portfolio

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   2,030,991.0000    99.24%

Mortgage- and Asset- Backed Portfolio

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/ FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

   3,673,814.0810    86.12%

Bank of America, N.A. is a national banking association organized under the laws of the United States, 101 South Tryon Street, Charlotte, North Carolina 28255. Bank of America Corporation, a publicly-traded financial services corporation, is the ultimate parent company of Bank of America, N.A.

FIM Funding, Inc. is a non-depository credit institution organized under the laws of the United States, 401 North Tryon Street, Charlotte, North Carolina 28202. Bank of America Corporation is the ultimate parent company of FIM Funding, Inc.

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated is a registered broker-dealer organized under the laws of the United States, One Bryant Park, New York, New York 10036. Bank of America Corporation is the ultimate parent company of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated.

 

236


Table of Contents

 

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In June 2004, an action captioned John E. Gallus et al. v. American Express Financial Corp. and American Express Financial Advisors Inc., was filed in the United States District Court for the District of Arizona. The plaintiffs allege that they are investors in several American Express Company (now known as RiverSource) mutual funds and they purport to bring the action derivatively on behalf of those funds under the 1940 Act. The plaintiffs allege that fees allegedly paid to the defendants by the funds for investment advisory and administrative services are excessive. The plaintiffs seek remedies including restitution and rescission of investment advisory and distribution agreements. The plaintiffs voluntarily agreed to transfer this case to the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota (the District Court). In response to defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint, the District Court dismissed one of plaintiffs’ four claims and granted plaintiffs limited discovery. Defendants moved for summary judgment in April 2007. Summary judgment was granted in the defendants’ favor on July 9, 2007. The plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal with the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals (the Eighth Circuit) on August 8, 2007. On April 8, 2009, the Eighth Circuit reversed summary judgment and remanded to the District Court for further proceedings. On August 6, 2009, defendants filed a writ of certiorari with the U.S. Supreme Court (the Supreme Court), asking the Supreme Court to stay the District Court proceedings while the Supreme Court considered and ruled in a case captioned Jones v. Harris Associates, which involved issues of law similar to those presented in the Gallus case. On March 30, 2010, the Supreme Court issued its ruling in Jones v. Harris Associates, and on April 5, 2010, the Supreme Court vacated the Eighth Circuit’s decision in the Gallus case and remanded the case to the Eighth Circuit for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates. On June 4, 2010, the Eighth Circuit remanded the Gallus case to the District Court for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates.

In December 2005, without admitting or denying the allegations, American Express Financial Corporation (AEFC, which is now known as Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (Ameriprise Financial)), entered into settlement agreements with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and Minnesota Department of Commerce (MDOC) related to market timing activities. As a result, AEFC was censured and ordered to cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of certain provisions of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, the 1940 Act, and various Minnesota laws. AEFC agreed to pay disgorgement of $10 million and civil money penalties of $7 million. AEFC also agreed to retain an independent distribution consultant to assist in developing a plan for distribution of all disgorgement and civil penalties ordered by the SEC in accordance with various undertakings detailed at http://www.sec.gov/litigation/admin/ia-2451.pdf. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have cooperated with the SEC and the MDOC in these legal proceedings, and have made regular reports to the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds’ Boards of Directors/Trustees.

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions, and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that the Funds are not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial nor any of its affiliates are the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds. Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the SEC on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

There can be no assurance that these matters, or the adverse publicity associated with them, will not result in increased fund redemptions, reduced sale of fund shares or other adverse consequences to the Funds. Further, although we believe proceedings are not likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds, these proceedings are subject to uncertainties and, as such, we are unable to estimate the possible loss or range of loss that may result. An adverse outcome in one or more of these proceedings could result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties or other relief that could have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations of Ameriprise Financial.

 

237


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A — DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

This Appendix summarizes the various descriptions of securities ratings applicable to securities purchased by the Columbia Funds. Please refer to a Fund’s prospectus and statement of additional information to determine whether that Fund may invest in securities that have ratings described in this Appendix.

STANDARD & POOR’S (S&P)

Bonds

The following summarizes the ratings used by S&P for bonds. The ratings AAA, AA, A and BBB denote investment grade securities.

AAA bonds have the highest rating assigned by S&P and are considered to have an extremely strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

AA bonds are considered to have a very strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, and they differ from AAA only in small degree.

A bonds are considered to have a strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher rated categories.

BBB bonds are considered to have an adequate capacity to pay interest and repay principal. Whereas they normally exhibit adequate protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity to pay interest and repay principal than for bonds in the A category.

BB, B, CCC, CC and C bonds are considered to have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation. BB indicates the lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree. While such debt will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or large exposures to adverse conditions.

BB bonds are considered to have less near-term vulnerability to default than other speculative issues. However, they face major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments. The BB rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BBB – rating.

B bonds are considered to have a greater vulnerability to default but currently have the capacity to meet interest payments and principal repayments. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to pay interest and repay principal. The B rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BB or BB – rating.

CCC bonds are considered to have a currently identifiable vulnerability to default, and are dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions to meet timely payment of interest and repayment of principal. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the bonds are not likely to have the capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The CCC rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied B or B – rating.

CC rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC rating.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

C rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC – debt rating. The C rating may be used to cover a situation, for example, where a bankruptcy petition has been filed, but debt service payments are continued.

CI rating is reserved for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

D bonds are in payment default. The D rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments are not made on the date due even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made during such grace period. The D rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.

Plus (+) or minus (-): The ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus or minus sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

Municipal Notes

SP-1. Notes rated SP-1 are considered to have very strong or strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designated as SP-1+.

SP-2. Notes rated SP-2 are considered to have satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest.

Notes due in three years or less normally receive a note rating. Notes maturing beyond three years normally receive a bond rating, although the following criteria are used in making that assessment:

Amortization schedule (the larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely the issue will be rated as a note).

Source of payment (the more dependent the issue is on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it will be rated as a note).

Commercial Paper

A. Issues assigned this highest rating are regarded as having the greatest capacity for timely payment. Issues in this category are further refined with the designations 1, 2, and 3 to indicate the relative degree of safety.

A-1. Issues assigned to this rating are considered to have overwhelming or very strong capacity for timely payment. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designed A-1+.

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. (MOODY’S)

Municipal Bonds

Aaa bonds are considered to be of the best quality. They are considered to have the smallest degree of investment risk and are generally referred to as “gilt edge”. Interest payments are protected by a large or by an exceptionally stable margin and principal is secure. While various protective elements are likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair a fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Aa bonds are considered to be of high quality by all standards. Together with Aaa bonds they comprise what are generally known as high-grade bonds. They are rated lower than the best bonds because margins of protection may not be as large in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective elements may be of greater amplitude or there may be other elements present which make the long-term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

 

A-2


Table of Contents

 

Those bonds in the Aa through B groups that Moody’s believes possess the strongest investment attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1, A1 or Baa1.

A bonds are considered to possess many favorable investment attributes and are to be considered to be upper-medium-grade obligations. Factors giving security to principal and interest are considered adequate, but elements may be present that suggest a susceptibility to impairment at some time in the future.

Baa bonds are considered to be medium grade obligations: they are neither highly protected nor poorly secured. Interest payments and principal security appear adequate for the present but certain protective elements may be lacking or may be characteristically unreliable over any great period of time. Such bonds lack outstanding investment characteristics and, in fact, have speculative characteristics as well.

Ba bonds are considered to have speculative elements: their future cannot be considered as well secured. Often, the protection of interest and principal payments may be very moderate and thereby not well safeguarded during both good and bad times in the future. Uncertainty of position characterizes bonds in this grade.

B bonds are considered generally to lack characteristics of a desirable investment. Assurance of interest and principal payments or of maintenance of other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Caa bonds are considered to be of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Ca bonds are considered to represent obligations that are speculative in a high degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

C bonds are the lowest rated class of bonds and issues so rated are considered to have extremely poor prospects of ever attaining any real investment standing.

Conditional Ratings. Bonds for which the security depends upon the completion of some act or the fulfillment of some condition are rated conditionally. These are bonds secured by (a) earnings of projects under construction, (b) earnings of projects unseasoned in operating experience, (c) rentals which begin when facilities are completed, or (d) payments to which some other limiting conditions attach. Parenthetical rating denotes probable credit stature upon completion of construction or elimination of basis of condition.

Corporate Bonds

The description of the applicable rating symbols (Aaa, Aa, A, Baa, etc.) and their meanings is identical to that of the Municipal Bond ratings as set forth above, except for the numerical modifiers. Moody’s applies numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 in the Aa and A classifications of its corporate bond rating system. The modifier 1 indicates that the security ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a midrange ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates that the issuer ranks in the lower end of its generic rating category.

Municipal Notes

MIG 1. This designation denotes best quality. There is present strong protection by established cash flows, superior liquidity support or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.

MIG 2. This designation denotes high quality. Margins of protection are ample although not so large as in the preceding group.

 

A-3


Table of Contents

 

MIG 3. This designation denotes favorable quality. All security elements are accounted for, but there is lacking the undeniable strength of the preceding grades. Liquidity and cash flow protection may be narrow and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.

Commercial Paper

Moody’s employs the following three designations, all judged to be investment grade, to indicate the relative repayment capacity of rated issuers:

Prime-1 Highest Quality

Prime-2 Higher Quality

Prime-3 High Quality

If an issuer represents to Moody’s that its commercial paper obligations are supported by the credit of another entity or entities, Moody’s, in assigning ratings to such issuers, evaluates the financial strength of the indicated affiliated corporations, commercial banks, insurance companies, foreign governments, or other entities, but only as one factor in the total rating assessment.

FITCH, INC. (FITCH)

Long-Term Debt

Investment Grade Bond Ratings

AAA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of the highest credit quality. The obligor has an exceptionally strong ability to pay interest and/or dividends and repay principal, which is unlikely to be affected by reasonably foreseeable events.

AA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of very high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is very strong, although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA. Because bonds rated in the AAA and AA categories are not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable future developments, short-term debt of these issuers is generally rated F-1+.

A bonds are considered to be investment grade and of high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered to be strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances than debt securities with higher ratings.

BBB bonds are considered to be investment grade and of satisfactory credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest or dividends and repay principal is considered to be adequate. Adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances, however, are more likely to have adverse impact on these securities and, therefore, impair timely payment. The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall below investment grade is higher than for securities with higher ratings.

Speculative Grade Bond Ratings

BB bonds are considered speculative. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes. However, business and financial alternatives can be identified, which could assist the obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B bonds are considered highly speculative. While securities in this class are currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely payment of principal and interest reflects the obligor’s limited margin of safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the life of the issue.

 

A-4


Table of Contents

 

CCC bonds are considered to have certain identifiable characteristics that, if not remedied, may lead to default. The ability to meet obligations requires an advantageous business and economic environment.

CC bonds are considered to be minimally protected. Default in payment of interest and/or principal seems probable over time.

C bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments. Such securities are extremely speculative and should be valued on the basis of their ultimate recovery value in liquidation or reorganization of the obligor. DDD represents the highest potential for recovery on these securities and D represents the lowest potential for recovery.

Plus (+) or minus (-): Plus or minus signs are used to show relative standing within the major rating categories. Plus and minus signs, however, are not used in the DDD, DD, or D categories.

Short-Term Debt

Fitch’s short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand or have original maturities of up to three years, including commercial paper, certificates of deposit, medium-term notes, and investment notes.

F-1+ obligations have exceptionally strong credit quality and are considered to have the strongest degree of assurance for timely payment.

F-1 obligations are considered to reflect an assurance of timely payment only slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2 obligations are considered to have good credit quality. Securities in this class have a satisfactory degree of assurance for timely payment, but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned F-1+ and F-1 ratings.

F-3 obligations are considered to have characteristics suggesting that the degree of assurance for timely payment is adequate; however, near-term adverse changes could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a minimal degree of assurance for timely payment and to be vulnerable to near-term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions.

B obligations are considered to have a minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments and a susceptibility to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

C rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a high default risk and whose capacity for meeting financial commitments is solely reliant upon a sustained, favorable business and economic environment.

D obligations are in actual or imminent payment default.

 

A-5


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B — PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT INVESTMENT ADVISERS, LLC

PROXY VOTING POLICY FOR LEGACY COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT CLIENTS

EFFECTIVE MAY 1, 2010

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (CMIA) has adopted the attached Proxy Voting Policy for purposes of voting proxies of securities held in certain client accounts1, with the following changes:

 

   

References to Columbia Management Advisors, LLC and CMA are deemed to be references to Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC; and

 

   

References to Bank of America Corporation and BAC are deemed to be references to Ameriprise Financial, Inc.

In addition, the text of footnote 1 in the Proxy Voting Policy is hereby deleted and replaced with the following:

Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the corporate parent of Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, and all of its numerous affiliates own, operate and have interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between Ameriprise Financial, Inc. or its affiliates and those of clients advised by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. For example, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. and its affiliates may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

1 On April 30, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of CMIA, acquired from Bank of America, N.A. a portion of the asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC, the parent company of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”). In connection with this transaction, CMIA became the investment adviser of certain client accounts previously advised by CMA. CMIA will apply CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy to certain of these and other client accounts.

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) Proxy Voting Policy

 

Last Review Date:

   April 2010
Applicable Regulatory Authority:   

Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940

Form N-PX

ERISA Department of Labor Bulletin 08-2

Institutional Shareholder Services, Inc. (SEC No Action Letter dated September 15, 2004)

Explanation/Summary of Regulatory Requirements

An investment adviser that exercises voting authority over clients’ proxies must adopt written policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that those proxies are voted in the best economic interests of clients. An adviser’s policies and procedures must address how the adviser resolves material conflicts of interest between its interests and those of its clients. An investment adviser must comply with certain record keeping and disclosure requirements with respect to its proxy voting responsibilities. In addition, an investment adviser to Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) accounts has an affirmative obligation to vote proxies for an ERISA account, unless the client expressly retains proxy voting authority.

Policy Summary

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) has adopted and implemented the following policy, which it believes is reasonably designed to: (1) ensure that proxies are voted in the best economic interest of clients; and (2) address material conflicts of interest that may arise. This policy applies primarily to the Global Wealth and Investment Management (“GWIM”) Investment Operations Group, the Investment groups (particularly, Equity and Chief Investment Officer’s Office), as well as to Compliance Risk Management (“CRM”) and Legal. CRM and Business groups to which this policy directly applies must adopt written procedures to implement this Policy.

Policy

All proxies regarding client securities for which CMA has authority to vote will, unless CMA determines in accordance with policies stated below to refrain from voting, be voted in a manner considered by CMA to be in the best interest of CMA’s clients without regard to any resulting benefit or detriment to CMA, its associates, or its affiliates. The best interest of clients is defined for this purpose as the interest of enhancing or protecting the economic value of client accounts, considered as a group rather than individually, as CMA determines in its sole and absolute discretion. In the event a client believes that its other interests require a different vote, CMA will vote as the client clearly instructs, provided CMA receives such instructions in time to act accordingly. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential. Therefore, the information may be shared on a need to know basis only, including within CMA and with CMA affiliates. Advisory clients, including mutual funds’ and other funds’ boards, may obtain information on how their proxies were voted by CMA. However, CMA will not selectively disclose its investment company clients’ proxy voting records to third parties. Rather, the investment company clients’ proxy records will be disclosed to shareholders by publicly-available annual filings for 12-month periods ending each year on June 30th on Form N-PX.

CMA endeavors to vote, in accordance with this Policy, all proxies of which it becomes aware prior to the vote deadline date, subject to certain general exceptions described below.

CMA seeks to avoid the occurrence of actual or apparent material conflicts of interest in the proxy voting process by voting in accordance with predetermined voting guidelines and observing other procedures that are intended to prevent where practicable and manage conflicts of interest (refer to Conflicts of Interest section below). CMA’s proxy voting policy and practices are summarized in its Form ADV. Additionally, CMA will provide clients with a copy of its policies, as they may be updated from time to time, upon request.

 

B-2


Table of Contents

 

Means of Achieving Compliance

The Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations is primarily responsible for overseeing the day-to-day operations of the proxy voting process. The Proxy Group’s monitoring will take into account the following elements: (1) periodic review of the proxy vendor’s votes to ensure that the proxy vendor is accurately voting consistent with CMA’s Voting Guidelines; and (2) review of the Columbia Funds’ fund website to ensure that annual proxy voting reports are posted in a timely and accurate manner. CMA has established a Proxy Committee which is responsible for overseeing the proxy voting process.

The specific responsibilities of the Proxy Committee and scope of its oversight are described in the Proxy Committee’s charter.

CMA’S INVESTMENT ASSOCIATES’ RESPONSIBILITIES

Under CMA’s Voting Guidelines, certain matters must be determined on a case-by-case basis. In general, the Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations will refer these matters first to the relevant CMA research analyst after first confirming that the proxy matter does not present a potential conflict to CMA. If there is not a research analyst assigned to the particular security, the matter will be referred to the appropriate portfolio manager.

In considering a particular proxy matter, the research analyst or portfolio manager must vote in the clients’ best interest as defined above. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential information. Therefore, research analysts and portfolio managers generally must not discuss proxy votes with any person outside of CMA and within CMA except on a need to know basis only.

Research analysts and portfolio managers must discharge their responsibilities consistent with the obligations set forth below (refer to Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures). A research analyst or portfolio manager must disclose in writing any inappropriate attempt to influence their recommendation or any other personal interest that they have with the issuer (see Appendix B – Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form). For each Proxy Referral (defined below), the research analyst or portfolio manager is responsible for memorializing their recommendation on the Proxy Voting Recommendation Form (see Appendix C) and communicating their recommendation to the Proxy Group.

Research analysts and portfolio managers should seek advice from CRM or Legal with respect to any questions that they have regarding personal conflicts of interests, communications regarding proxies, or other related matters.

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

For purposes of this policy, a material conflict of interest is a relationship or activity engaged in by CMA, a CMA affiliate1, or a CMA associate that creates an incentive (or appearance thereof) to favor the interests of CMA, the affiliate, or associate, rather than the clients’ interests. However, a material conflict of interest is not automatically created when there is a relationship or activity engaged in by a CMA affiliate, but there is a possibility that a CMA affiliate could cause a conflict. CMA may have a conflict of interest if either CMA has a significant business relationship with a company that is soliciting a proxy, or if a CMA associate involved in the proxy voting decision-making process has a significant personal or family relationship with the particular

 

1 Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”), the ultimate corporate parent of CMA, Bank of America, N.A. and all of their numerous affiliates owns, operates and has interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between BAC or its affiliates and those of CMA-advised clients. For example, the commercial and investment banking business lines may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with CMA’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

B-3


Table of Contents

company. A conflict of interest is considered to be “material” to the extent that a reasonable person could expect the conflict to influence CMA’s decision on the particular vote at issue. In all cases where there is deemed to be a material conflict of interest, CMA will seek to resolve said conflict in the clients’ best interests.

For those proxy proposals that: (1) are not addressed by CMA’s proxy voting guidelines; (2) the guidelines specify the issue must be evaluated and determined on a case-by-case basis; or (3) a CMA investment associate believes that an exception to the guidelines may be in the best economic interest of CMA’s clients (collectively, “Proxy Referrals”), CMA may vote the proxy, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures set forth below.

In the case of Proxy Referrals, CRM identifies companies with which CMA has a significant business relationships and Proxy Referrals of such companies will be voted consistent with CMA’s conflicts management procedures described below. For Proxy Referrals that do not involve companies with which CMA has a significant business relationship the relevant CMA investment personnel (i.e. research analyst, portfolio manager, members of Proxy Committee) involved in the particular Proxy Referral must report any personal conflict of interest circumstances (e.g., relationships with nominees for directorship, members of an issuer’s or dissident’s management or otherwise, unusual communications with parties outside the investment organization concerning a proxy matter) to Columbia Management’s Conflicts of Interest Officer in writing (see Appendix B). In the event any member of the Proxy Committee has a conflict of interest regarding a given matter, he or she will similarly disclose the circumstance and abstain from participating in the Committee’s determination of whether and/or how to vote in the matter.

If the Proxy Committee, the Chairperson of the Proxy Committee, or the Conflicts Officer determines that a proxy matter presents a material conflict of interest, or a material conflict of interest is otherwise determined to exist through the application of this Policy, CMA will invoke one or more of the following conflict management procedures:

 

   

Causing the proxies to be voted in accordance with the recommendations of an independent third party (which generally will be CMA’s proxy voting agent);

 

   

Causing the proxies to be delegated to a qualified, independent third party, which may include CMA’s proxy voting agent; or

 

   

In unusual cases, with the Client’s consent and upon ample notice, forwarding the proxies to CMA’s clients so that they may vote the proxies directly.

Affiliate Investment Companies and Public Companies

CMA considers (1) proxies solicited by open-end and closed-end investment companies for which CMA or an affiliate serves as an investment adviser or principal underwriter; and (2) proxies solicited by Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”) or other public companies within the BAC organization to present a material conflict of interest for CMA. Consequently, the proxies of such affiliates will be voted following one of the conflict management practices discussed above.

Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures

In certain circumstances, CMA follows the proxy guidelines and uses other research services provided by the proxy vendor or another independent third party. CMA reviews its proxy vendor’s conflicts of interest procedures as part of its oversight of the proxy vendor’s services.

CMA and other BAC affiliates have adopted various other policies and procedures that help reinforce this Policy. Please see any associated documents.

Ownership Limits – Delegation of Proxy Voting to an Independent Third Party

From time to time, CMA may face regulatory or compliance limits on the types or amounts of voting securities that it may purchase or hold for client accounts. Among other limits, federal, state, foreign regulatory restrictions, or company-specific ownership limits may restrict the total percentage of an issuer’s voting securities that CMA can hold for clients (collectively, “Ownership Limits”).

 

B-4


Table of Contents

 

The regulations or company-specific documents governing a number of these Ownership Limits often focus upon holdings in voting securities. As a result, in limited circumstances in order to comply with such Ownership Limits and/or internal policies designed to comply with such limits, CMA may delegate proxy voting in certain issuers to a qualified, independent third party, who may be CMA’s proxy voting agent.

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

A. CMA’s Proxy Voting Guidelines – General Practices.

The Proxy Committee has adopted the guidelines for voting proxies specified in Appendix A of this policy. CMA uses an independent, third-party proxy vendor to implement its proxy voting process as CMA’s proxy voting agent. In general, whenever a vote is solicited, the proxy vendor will execute the vote according to CMA’s Voting Guidelines.

B. Ability to Vote Proxies Other than as Provided by Voting Guidelines.

A Portfolio Manager or other party involved with a client’s account may conclude that the best interest of the firm’s client, as defined above, requires that a proxy be voted in a manner that differs from the predetermined proxy Voting Guidelines. In this situation, he or she will request in writing that the Proxy Committee consider voting the proxy other than according to such Guidelines and provide information as the Proxy Committee may request. The Proxy Committee may consider the matter, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures discussed above.

C. Other Proxy Matters

For the following categories, proxies will be voted as stated below:

1. New Proposals. For certain new proposals that are expected to be proposed to shareholders of multiple companies, the Proxy Committee may develop a Voting Guideline which will be incorporated into this Policy.

2. Accounts Adhering to Taft Hartley Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to Taft Hartley principles will be voted according to the Taft Hartley Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor.

3. Accounts Adhering to Socially Responsible Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to socially responsible principles will be voted according to the Socially Responsible Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client.

4. Proxies of International Issuers. In general, CMA will refrain from voting securities in cases where international issuers impose share blocking restrictions. However, in the exceptional circumstances that CMA determines that it would be appropriate to vote such securities, all proposals for these securities will be voted only on the specific instruction of the Proxy Committee and to the extent practicable in accordance with the Voting Guidelines set forth in this Policy. Additionally, proxies will typically not be voted in markets where powers of attorney are required to be executed in order to vote shares.

5. Proxy Referrals for Passive Index Accounts. Proxy Referrals for a security that is held only within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and not in any other account within CMA, shall be voted according to the guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client. However, if a security is held within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and within another CMA-managed account (including without limitation an account actively managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group), all proposals, including Proxy Referrals, will be voted in accordance with the Voting Guidelines, subject to the other provisions of this Policy.

6. Proxy Voting for Securities on Loan. CMA generally votes in cases where shares have been loaned from actively managed Columbia Funds as long as the shares have been recalled in a timely manner. However, CMA generally does not vote shares that have been loaned from passively managed Columbia Index Funds. Other CMA clients may have their own stock loan programs and may or may not recall their shares for proxy voting.

 

B-5


Table of Contents

 

Supervision

Managers and supervisory personnel are responsible for ensuring that their associates understand and follow this policy and any applicable procedures adopted by the business group to implement the policy. The Proxy Committee has ultimate responsibility for the implementation of this Policy.

Escalation

With the exception of conflicts of interest-related matters, issues arising under this policy should be escalated to the Proxy Committee. Issues involving potential or actual conflicts of interest should be promptly communicated to the Columbia Management Conflicts Officer.

Monitoring/Oversight

CRM and/or Corporate Internal Audit Group perform periodic reviews and assessments of various lines of businesses, including a review of Columbia Management’s compliance with the Proxy Voting Policy.

Recordkeeping

CMA will create and maintain records of each investment company’s proxy record for 12-month periods ended June 30th. CMA will compile the following information for each matter relating to a portfolio security considered at any shareholder meeting during the period covered by the annual report and for which CMA was entitled to vote:

 

   

The name of the issuer of the security;

 

   

The exchange ticker symbol of the portfolio security (if symbol is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The Council on Uniform Securities Identification Procedures number for the portfolio security (if number is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The shareholder meeting date;

 

   

A brief identification of the matter voted on;

 

   

Whether the matter was proposed by the issuer or by a security holder;

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote on the matter;

 

   

How the company cast its vote (e.g., for or against proposal, or abstain; for or withhold regarding the election of directors); and

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote for or against management.

Business groups and support partners are responsible for maintaining all records necessary to evidence compliance with this policy. The records must be properly maintained and readily accessible in order to evidence compliance with this policy.

 

B-6


Table of Contents

 

These records include:

 

Document

  

Responsible Party

Proxy Committee Meeting Minutes and Related Materials    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Proxy Vote Recommendation Form and Supporting Materials of Investment Management Personnel Concerning Proxy Decisions and Recommendations (or any other document created by CMA that was material to making a voting decision or that memorializes the basis for the voting decision)    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Conflicts of Interest Review Documentation, including Conflicts of Interest Forms    Compliance Risk Management
Client Communications Regarding Proxy Matters    Client Service Group
Copy of Each Applicable Proxy Statement Unless it has been Filed with the SEC and may be Obtained from the SEC’s EDGAR System    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations

Records should be retained for a period of not less than six years plus the current year. Records must be retained in an appropriate office of CM for the first three years.

 

B-7


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A – CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy

CMA’S VOTING GUIDELINES

A. The Proxy Committee has adopted the following guidelines for voting proxies:

1. Matters Relating to the Board of Directors/Corporate Governance

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals for the election of directors or for an increase or decrease in the number of directors, provided that no more than one-third of the Board of Directors would, presently or at any time during the previous three-year period, be from management.

However, CMA generally will WITHHOLD votes from pertinent director nominees if:

 

  (i) the board as proposed to be constituted would have more than one-third of its members from management;

 

  (ii) the board does not have audit, nominating, and compensation committees composed solely of directors who qualify as being regarded as “independent,” i.e. having no material relationship, directly or indirectly, with the Company, as CMA’s proxy voting agent may determine (subject to the Proxy Committee’s contrary determination of independence or non-independence);

 

  (iii) the nominee, as a member of the audit committee, permitted the company to incur excessive non-audit fees (as defined below regarding other business matters — ratification of the appointment of auditors);

 

  (iv) a director serves on more than six public company boards;

 

  (v) the CEO serves on more than two public company boards other than the company’s board; or

 

  (vi) CMA generally will vote AGAINST Director nominee of a company who is chief executive officer of another company on whose board the company’s chief executive officer sits (i.e. interlocking executives).

One a CASE-BY-CASE basis, CMA may WITHHOLD votes for a director nominee who has failed to observe good corporate governance practices or, through specific corporate action or inaction (e.g. failing to implement policies for which a majority of shareholders has previously cast votes in favor; served voted for the adoption of a poison pill without approval of shareholders), has demonstrated a disregard for the interests of shareholders.

 

   

Proposals requesting that the board audit, compensation and/or nominating committee be composed solely of independent directors. The Audit Committee must satisfy the independence and experience requirements established by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and the New York Stock Exchange, or appropriate local requirements for foreign securities. At least one member of the Audit Committee must qualify as a “financial expert” in accordance with SEC rules.

 

   

Proposals to declassify a board, absent special circumstances that would indicate that shareholder interests are better served by a classified board structure.

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to separate the role of Chairman of the Board and CEO.

 

   

Proposals that grant or restore shareholder ability to remove directors with or without cause.

 

   

Proposals to permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that encourage directors to own a minimum amount of company stock.

 

   

Proposals to provide or to restore shareholder appraisal rights.

 

   

Proposals for the company to adopt confidential voting.

 

B-8


Table of Contents

 

CMA will generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for majority voting thresholds for director elections unless the company has adopted formal corporate governance principles that present a meaningful alternative to the majority voting standard and/or provides an adequate response to both new nominees as well as incumbent nominees who fail to receive a majority of votes cast.

CMA will generally vote FOR 162(m) bonus plans unless the Proxy Administrator recommends voting against a specific plan, in which case CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to classify boards, absent special circumstances indicating that shareholder interests would be better served by a classified board structure.

 

   

Proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board without shareholder approval.

 

   

Proposals that provide directors may be removed only by supermajority vote.

 

   

Proposals which allow more than one vote per share in the election of directors.

 

   

Proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that mandate a minimum amount of company stock that directors must own.

 

   

Proposals to limit the tenure of non-management directors.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

In contested elections of directors. Proposals to adopt or eliminate cumulative voting.

 

   

CMA generally will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on board approved proposals relating to corporate governance. Such proposals include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Reimbursement of proxy solicitation expenses taking into consideration whether or not CMA was in favor of the dissidents.

 

   

Proxy contest advance notice. CMA generally will vote FOR proposals that allow shareholders to submit proposals as close to the meeting date as possible while allowing for sufficient time for Company response, SEC review, and analysis by other shareholders.

 

   

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis to indemnify directors and officers, and AGAINST proposals to indemnify external auditors.

 

   

CMA will vote FOR the indemnification of internal auditors, unless the costs associated with the approval are not disclosed.

2. Compensation

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

CMA generally will vote FOR management sponsored compensation plans (such as bonus plans, incentive plans, stock option plans, pension and retirement benefits, stock purchase plans or thrift plans) if they are consistent with industry and country standards.

 

   

Proposals requiring that executive severance arrangements be submitted for shareholder ratification.

 

   

Proposals asking a company to expense stock options.

 

   

Proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

 

   

Employee stock purchase plans that have the following features: (i) the shares purchased under the plan are acquired for no less than 85% of their market value, (ii) the offering period under the plan is 27 months or less, and (iii) dilution is 10% or less.

 

B-9


Table of Contents

 

   

Shareholder proposals to adopt a non-binding advisory vote on Executive Compensation (“Say on Pay”).

 

   

CMA recognizes that individual compensation committees are in the best position to determine the optimal design of share based plans. However, CMA generally prefers a greater use of restricted stock in place of stock options due to the greater uncertainty involved with the valuation of stock options at the time of issue.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Stock option plans that permit issuance of options with an exercise price below the stock’s current market price, or that permit replacing or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals to authorize the replacement or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals requesting that plan administrators have advance authority to amend the terms of a plan without detailed disclosure of the specific amendments. When sufficient details are provided on the amendments permitted by the advance authority, CMA will recommend on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

CMA generally is opposed to compensation plans that substantially dilute ownership interest in a company, provide participants with excessive awards, or have objectionable structural features. Specifically, for equity-based plans, if the proposed number of shares authorized for option programs (excluding authorized shares for expired options) exceeds 5% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years, or exceeds 1% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years (for directors only), CMA will vote on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. CMA requires that management provide substantial justification for the repricing of options.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals regarding approval of specific executive severance arrangements.

 

   

-Management proposals regarding “Say on Pay” (i.e. non-binding advisory vote on pay).

 

   

Proposals that involve awarding 50% or more of the equity shares of an equity-based compensation plan to the top five or fewer executives.

3. Capitalization

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to increase the authorized shares for stock dividends, stock splits (and reverse stock splits) or general issuance, unless proposed as an anti-takeover measure or a general issuance proposal increases the authorization by more than 30% without a clear need presented by the company. Proposals for reverse stock splits should include an overall reduction in authorization.

For companies recognizing preemptive rights for existing shareholders, CMA generally will vote FOR general issuance proposals that increase the authorized shares by more than 30%. CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all such proposals by companies that do not recognize preemptive rights for existing shareholders.

 

   

Proposals for the elimination of authorized but unissued shares or retirement of those shares purchased for sinking fund or treasury stock.

 

   

Proposals to institute/renew open market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

 

   

Proposals to reduce or change the par value of common stock, provided the number of shares is also changed in order to keep the capital unchanged.

 

B-10


Table of Contents

 

CMA will evaluate on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals regarding:

 

   

Management proposals that allow listed companies to de-list and terminate the registration of their common stock. CMA will determine whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by giving consideration to:

 

   

Whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly traded.

 

   

Cash-out value

 

   

Balanced interests of continuing vs. cashed-out shareholders

 

   

Market reaction to public announcement of transaction

4. Mergers, Restructurings and Other Transactions

CMA will review, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, business transactions such as mergers, acquisitions, reorganizations, liquidations, spinoffs, buyouts and sale of all or substantially all of a company’s assets.

5. Anti-Takeover Measures

CMA generally will vote AGAINST proposals intended largely to avoid acquisition prior to the occurrence of an actual event or to discourage acquisition by creating a cost constraint. With respect to the following measures, CMA generally will vote as follows:

Poison Pills

 

   

CMA votes FOR shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification.

 

   

CMA generally votes FOR shareholder proposals to eliminate a poison pill.

 

   

CMA generally votes AGAINST management proposals to ratify a poison pill.

 

Greenmail

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or to otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

Supermajority vote

 

   

CMA will vote AGAINST board-approved proposals to adopt anti-takeover measures such as supermajority voting provisions, issuance of blank check preferred stock, the creation of a separate class of stock with disparate voting rights and charter amendments adopting control share acquisition provisions.

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share acquisition statutes.

6. Other Business Matters

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Bylaw amendments giving holders of at least 25% of outstanding common stock the ability to call a special meeting of stockholders.

 

   

Board governance document amendments or other proposals which give the lead independent director the authority to call special meetings of the independent directors at any time.

 

B-11


Table of Contents

 

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to approve routine business matters such as changing the company’s name and procedural matters relating to the shareholder meeting such as approving the minutes of a prior meeting.

 

   

Proposals to ratify the appointment of auditors, unless any of the following apply in which case CMA will generally vote AGAINST the proposal:

 

   

Credible reason exists to question:

 

   

The auditor’s independence, as determined by applicable regulatory requirements.

 

   

The accuracy or reliability of the auditor’s opinion as to the company’s financial position.

 

   

Fees paid to the auditor or its affiliates for “non-audit” services exceeds 25% of the total fees paid for “audit,” “audit-related” and “tax compliance” and/or “tax return preparation” services, as disclosed in the company’s proxy materials.

 

   

Bylaw or charter changes that are of a housekeeping nature (e.g., updates or corrections).

 

   

Proposals to approve the annual reports and accounts provided the certifications required by the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 have been provided.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to eliminate the right of shareholders to act by written consent or call special meetings.

 

   

Proposals providing management with authority to adjourn an annual or special shareholder meeting absent compelling reasons, or to adopt, amend or repeal bylaws without shareholder approval, or to vote unmarked proxies in favor of management.

 

   

Shareholder proposals to change the date, time or location of the company’s annual meeting of shareholders.

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Authorization to transact other unidentified substantive (as opposed to procedural) business at a meeting.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals to change the location of the company’s state of incorporation. CMA considers whether financial benefits (e.g., reduced fees or taxes) likely to accrue to the company as a result of a reincorporation or other change of domicile outweigh any accompanying material diminution of shareholder rights.

 

   

Proposals on whether and how to vote on “bundled” or otherwise conditioned proposals, depending on the overall economic effects upon shareholders.

CMA generally will ABSTAIN from voting on shareholder proposals predominantly involving social, socio-economic, environmental, political or other similar matters on the basis that their impact on share value can rarely be anticipated with any high degree of confidence. CMA may, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, vote:

 

   

FOR proposals seeking inquiry and reporting with respect to, rather than cessation or affirmative implementation of, specific policies where the pertinent issue warrants separate communication to shareholders; and

 

   

FOR or AGAINST the latter sort of proposal in light of the relative benefits and detriments (e.g. distraction, costs, other burdens) to share value which may be expected to flow from passage of the proposal.

 

B-12


Table of Contents

 

7. Other Matters Relating to Foreign Issues

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Most stock (scrip) dividend proposals. CMA votes AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

 

   

Proposals to capitalize the company’s reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase the par value of shares.

 

   

Proposals to approve control and profit transfer agreements between a parent and its subsidiaries.

 

   

Management proposals seeking the discharge of management and supervisory board members, unless there is concern about the past actions of the company’s auditors/directors and/or legal action is being taken against the board by other shareholders.

 

   

Management proposals concerning allocation of income and the distribution of dividends, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

Proposals for the adoption of financing plans if they are in the best economic interests of shareholders.

CMA will generally vote FOR proposals to approve Directors’ Fees, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA will evaluate management proposals to approve protective preference shares for Netherlands located company-friendly foundations proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis and will only support resolutions if:

 

   

The supervisory board needs to approve an issuance of shares while the supervisory board is independent within the meaning of CMA’s categorization rules and the Dutch Corporate Governance Code.

 

   

No call/put option agreement exists between the company and the foundation.

 

   

There is a qualifying offer clause or there are annual management and supervisory board elections.

 

   

The issuance authority is for a maximum of 18 months.

 

   

The board of the company-friendly foundation is independent.

 

   

The company has disclosed under what circumstances it expects to make use of the possibility to issue preference shares.

 

   

There are no priority shares or other egregious protective or entrenchment tools.

 

   

The company releases its proxy circular, with details of the poison pill proposal, at least three weeks prior to the meeting.

 

   

Art 2:359c Civil Code of the legislative proposal has been implemented.

8. Investment Company Matters

Election of Directors:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the election of directors, considering the following factors:

 

   

Board structure

 

   

Attendance at board and committee meetings.

 

B-13


Table of Contents

 

CMA will WITHHOLD votes from directors who:

 

   

Attend less than 75 percent of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse for the absences. Valid reasons include illness or absence due to company business. Participation via telephone is acceptable. In addition, if the director missed only one meeting or one day’s meetings, votes should not be withheld even if such absence dropped the director’s attendance below 75 percent.

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal that is approved by a majority of shares outstanding;

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal this is approved by a majority of the votes cast for two consecutive years;

 

   

Are interested directors and sit on the audit or nominating committee; or

 

   

Are interested directors and the full board serves as the audit or nominating committee or the company does not have one of these committees.

Proxy Contests:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for proxy contests, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance relative to its peers

 

   

Market in which fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the pertinent issues (e.g., closed-end fund share market value discount to NAV)

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity and votes on related proposals

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents

 

   

Independence of incumbent directors; director nominees

 

   

Experience and skills of director nominees

 

   

Governance profile of the company

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund:

CMA will vote conversion proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance as a closed-end fund

 

   

Market in which the fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the discount

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals.

Investment Advisory Agreements:

CMA will vote investment advisory agreements on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Proposed and current fee schedules

 

   

Fund category/investment objective

 

   

Performance benchmarks

 

   

Share price performance as compared with peers

 

   

Resulting fees relative to peers

 

   

Assignments (where the adviser undergoes a change of control)

 

B-14


Table of Contents

 

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of new classes or series of shares.

Preferred Stock Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the authorization for or increase in the preferred shares, considering the following factors:

 

   

Stated specific financing purpose

 

   

Possible dilution for common shares

 

   

Whether the shares can be used for anti-takeover purposes

Policies Addressed by the Investment Company Act of 1940 (“1940 Act”):

CMA will vote proposals regarding adoption or changes of policies addressed by the 1940 Act on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Regulatory developments

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Current and potential risk

CMA generally will vote FOR these amendments as long as the proposed changes do not fundamentally alter the investment focus of the fund and do comply with current SEC interpretations.

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Non-fundamental Restriction:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fundamental restriction to a non-fundamental restriction, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fund’s target investments

 

   

Reasons given by the fund for the change

 

   

Projected impact of the change on the portfolio

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Non-fundamental:

CMA will vote AGAINST proposals to change a fund’s investment objective from fundamental to non-fundamental unless management acknowledges meaningful limitations upon its future requested ability to change the objective

Name Change Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s name, considering the following factors:

 

   

Political/economic changes in the target market

 

   

Consolidation in the target market

 

   

Current asset composition

 

B-15


Table of Contents

 

Change in Fund’s Subclassification:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s subclassification, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Risk of concentration

 

   

Consolidation in target industry

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis these proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Strategies employed to salvage the company

 

   

Past performance of the fund

 

   

Terms of the liquidation

Changes to the Charter Document:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change the charter document, considering the following factors:

 

   

The degree of change implied by the proposal

 

   

The efficiencies that could result

 

   

The state of incorporation; net effect on shareholder rights

 

   

Regulatory standards and implications

CMA will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals allowing the Board to impose, without shareholder approval, fees payable upon redemption of fund shares, provided imposition of such fees is likely to benefit long-term fund investors (e.g., by deterring market timing activity by other fund investors)

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to amend, without shareholder approval, the fund’s management agreement(s) with its investment adviser(s) or sub-advisers, provided the amendment is not required by applicable law (including the Investment Company Act of 1940) or interpretations thereunder to require such approval

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to:

 

   

Change, without shareholder approval the domicile of the fund

 

   

Adopt, without shareholder approval, material amendments of the fund’s declaration of trust or other organizational document

Changing the Domicile of a Fund:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reincorporate, considering the following factors:

 

   

Regulations of both states

 

   

Required fundamental policies of both states

 

   

The increased flexibility available

 

B-16


Table of Contents

 

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval:

CMA will vote FOR proposals to enable the Board or Investment Adviser to hire and terminate sub-advisers, without shareholder approval, in accordance with applicable rules or exemptive orders under the Investment Company Act of 1940

Distribution Agreements:

CMA will vote these proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fees charged to comparably sized funds with similar objectives

 

   

The proposed distributor’s reputation and past performance

 

   

The competitiveness of the fund in the industry

 

   

Terms of the agreement

Master-Feeder Structure:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of a master-feeder structure.

Mergers:

CMA will vote merger proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Resulting fee structure

 

   

Performance of both funds

 

   

Continuity of management personnel

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights

Shareholder Proposals to Establish Director Ownership Requirement:

CMA will generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a specific minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board. While CMA favors stockownership on the part of directors, the company should determine the appropriate ownership requirement.

Shareholder Proposals to Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses.

Shareholder Proposals to Terminate the Investment Adviser:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to terminate the investment adviser, considering the following factors:

 

   

Performance of the fund’s NAV

 

   

The fund’s history of shareholder relations

 

   

The performance of other funds under the adviser’s management

 

B-17


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B

Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form

Conflict Review Questionnaire for Proxy Voting Working Group Members and Other Individuals

Participating in the Proxy Voting Decision-Making Process.

Instructions: Please complete each of the questions. Please provide an explanation for any affirmative responses. Return the completed questionnaire to Columbia Management Conflicts of Interest Officer.

 

 

 

Issuer and Proxy Matter:      

 

 

 

 

  1. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any management personnel of the issuer1?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  2. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any person participating, supporting, opposing or otherwise connected with the particular proxy proposal (e.g., principals of the issuer; director nominees of issuer company; shareholder activists)?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  3. Have you discussed this particular proxy proposal with anyone outside of Columbia Management’s investment group2?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

 

  4. Are you aware of any other potential personal conflicts of interest not described above? Please detail below.

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

Name:      
Signed:      
Date:      

 

1 Personal investing in the issuer by you or a member of your immediate family does not require an affirmative response to this item.
2 Communications with issuer or solicitors in the regular course of business would not have to be disclosed on this form.

 

B-18


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C

CMA Proxy Vote Recommendation/Proxy Committee Request Form

 

Name of Investment Associate:      

 

Company Name:      

 

Overview of Proxy Vote and Meeting Date:      

 

 

 

Proxy Agenda Item(s)

 

Description of Item:      
 
(The above information will be pre-populated by the Proxy Department.)

 

Recommendation (FOR, AGAINST, ABSTAIN) including brief rationale:      

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Please attach any supporting information other than analysis or reports provided by the Proxy Department.

 

 

 

Signed

By signing, I am certifying that I either have no conflicts of interest-related information to report or have sent a completed “Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form” to Compliance Risk Management (Conflicts Officer).

 

 

Send Completed Forms to:

GWIM Investment Operations – Proxy Department

        or

In the case of Proxy Votes to be referred to the Proxy Committee, submit this form and materials to the Chair of the Proxy Committee

 

B-19


Table of Contents

 

MacKay Shields Proxy Voting Policy and Procedures

MacKay Shields LLC

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

1. Introduction

MacKay Shields LLC (“MacKay Shields” or the “Firm”), has adopted these “Proxy Voting Policy and Procedures” (the “Policy”) to ensure the Firm’s compliance with Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (the “Advisers Act”) and other applicable fiduciary obligations. The Policy applies to proxies relating to securities held by clients of MacKay Shields who have delegated the responsibility of voting proxies to the Firm. The Policy is designed to assist Firm employees in meeting their specific responsibilities in this area and to ensure that proxies are voted in the best interests of the Firm’s clients.

2. Statement of Policy

2.1 It is the policy of MacKay Shields that where the Firm has voting authority, all proxies are to be voted in the best interest of the client without regard to the interests of MacKay Shields or other related parties. Specifically, MacKay Shields shall not subordinate the interests of clients to unrelated objectives. MacKay Shields shall act with the care, skill, prudence and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims. For purposes of the Policy, the “best interests of clients” shall mean, unless otherwise specified by the client, the clients’ best economic interests over the long term — that is, the common interest that all MacKay Shields clients share in seeing the value of a common investment increase over time. It is further the policy of the Firm that complete and accurate disclosure concerning its proxy voting policies and procedures and proxy voting records as required by the Advisers Act, be made available to its clients.

2.2 When proxies with respect to securities held by clients of MacKay Shields have not been received by MacKay Shields or its proxy voting service provider, MacKay Shields will make reasonable efforts to obtain missing proxies. MacKay Shields is not responsible for voting proxies it or its proxy voting service provider does not receive.

2.3 MacKay Shields may choose not to vote proxies under the following circumstances:

 

   

If the effect on the client’s economic interests or the value of the portfolio holding is indeterminable or insignificant;

 

   

If the cost of voting the proxy outweighs the possible benefit; or

 

   

If a jurisdiction imposes share blocking restrictions which prevent the Firm from trading shares.

3. Use of Third Party Proxy Voting Service Provider

To discharge its responsibility, MacKay Shields has examined third-party services that assist in the researching and voting of proxies and the development of voting guidelines. After such review, the Firm has selected RiskMetrics Group (“RM”), to assist it in researching voting proposals, analyzing the financial implications of voting proposals and voting proxies. MacKay Shields utilizes the research and analytical services, operational implementation, administration, record-keeping and reporting services provided by RM.

4. Proxy Voting Guidelines

4.1 MacKay Shields has determined that, except as set forth in Sections 6 and 7, proxies for non-union clients who so specify will be voted in accordance with the voting recommendations contained in the applicable

 

B-20


Table of Contents

RM non-union domestic or global proxy voting guidelines, as in effect from time to time (“Non-Union Guidelines”). A summary of the current Non-Union Guidelines is attached as Exhibit A.

4.2 MacKay Shields has determined that, except as set forth in Sections 6 and 7, proxies for union or Taft-Hartley clients who so specify will be voted in accordance with the voting recommendations contained in the applicable RM Taft-Hartley domestic or global proxy voting guidelines, as in effect from time to time (“Union Guidelines”). A summary of the current Union Guidelines is attached as Exhibit B.

4.3 For purposes of the Policy, the Non-Union and Union Guidelines are collectively referred to as the Standard Guidelines.

4.4 A client may choose to use proxy voting guidelines different from the Standard Guidelines (“Custom Guidelines”). Any Custom Guidelines must be furnished by the client to MacKay Shields in writing.

4.5 In the event the Standard Guidelines or any client’s Custom Guidelines do not address how a proxy should be voted or state that the vote is to be determined on a “case-by-case” basis, the proxy will be voted in accordance with RM recommendations, subject to Section 6. In the event that RM has not made a recommendation, MacKay Shields will follow the procedure set forth in Section 7.

4.6 Notwithstanding the foregoing, MacKay Shields will vote a proxy with respect to a particular security held by a client in accordance with such client’s specific request even if it is in a manner inconsistent with the Standard Guidelines or the client’s Custom Guidelines, as the case may be. Any such specific requests must be furnished to MacKay Shields by the client in writing and must be received by MacKay on a timely basis for instructing RM how to cast the vote.

4.7 In order to avoid possible conflicts of interest, MacKay Shields votes proxies based on the Standard Guidelines or a client’s Custom Guidelines, as the case may be. However, it is recognized that the Firm’s portfolio management team has the ultimate responsibility for proxy voting.

4.8 For clients using the Standard Guidelines, the Firm will instruct RM to cast votes in accordance with the Standard Guidelines. For clients using Custom Guidelines, the Firm will provide RM with a copy of such Custom Guidelines and will instruct RM to cast votes in accordance with such Custom Guidelines. RM will cast votes in accordance with the Standard Guidelines or Custom Guidelines, as the case may be, unless instructed otherwise by MacKay Shields as set forth in Sections 6 and 7. Upon receipt of a specific request from a client pursuant to Section 4.6, the Firm will instruct RM to cast such client’s proxy in accordance with such request.

5. Client Account Set-up and Review

5.1 Initially, MacKay Shields must determine whether the client seeks to retain the responsibility of voting proxies, or seeks to delegate that responsibility to the Firm. The marketing or client service person responsible for setting up the account, in conjunction with MacKay’s Legal/Compliance Department, will have primary responsibility for making that determination. In its sole discretion, the Firm may decline to accept authority to vote a client’s proxies. Any such refusal shall be in writing.

5.2 If MacKay Shields has authority to vote a client’s proxies, the marketing or client service person responsible for setting up the account will ask the client to specify in writing (which may be by e-mail) whether the Firm should vote proxies in accordance with the Non-Union Guidelines, Union Guidelines or Custom Guidelines.

5.3 In most cases, the delegation of voting authority to MacKay Shields, and the Firm’s use of a third-party proxy voting service provider shall be memorialized in the client’s investment management agreement.

 

B-21


Table of Contents

 

5.4 MacKay Shields shall notify RM of new client accounts using such form as RM shall specify from time to time. Designated personnel within the Firm will be responsible for ensuring that each new client’s account for which the Firm has proxy voting authority is established on the appropriate systems and that each such account is properly coded for voting under the appropriate Non-Union Guidelines, Union Guidelines or Custom Guidelines, as the case may be.

6. Overriding Guidelines

A portfolio manager may propose that a particular proxy vote be cast in a manner different from the Standard Guidelines or a RM voting recommendation, or may propose an abstention from voting, if he/she believes that to do so, based on all facts and circumstances, is in the best interest of the Firm’s clients as a whole. Any portfolio manager who proposes to override the Standard Guidelines or a RM voting recommendation on a particular vote or to abstain from voting must complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form, which is set forth in Schedule C.

7. Referral of Voting Decision by RM to MacKay Shields

7.1 In the event that the Standard Guidelines or a client’s Custom Guidelines do not address how a proxy should be voted on a specific proposal for an issuer and RM has not made a recommendation as to how such proxy should be voted, RM will so advise MacKay Shields. In that event, the Legal/Compliance Department will request that the appropriate portfolio manager make a voting recommendation and complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form.

7.2 In the event that the Standard Guidelines or a client’s Custom Guidelines require a “case-by-case” determination on a particular proxy vote and RM has not made a recommendation as to how such proxy should be voted, RM will so advise MacKay Shields. In that event, the Legal/Compliance Department will request that the appropriate portfolio manager make a voting recommendation and complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form.

7.3 In the event that RM determines that a conflict of interest exists as a result of which RM is precluded from making a recommendation as to how a proxy should be voted on a specific proposal for an issuer, RM will so advise MacKay Shields. In that event, the Legal/Compliance Department will request that the appropriate portfolio manager make a voting recommendation and complete a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form.

8. Conflicts of Interest

8.1 The Firm’s portfolio managers may make proxy voting decisions in connection with (i) overriding the Standard Guidelines or an RM voting recommendation pursuant to Section 6, or (ii) deciding on a vote pursuant to Section 7. In such event, the portfolio managers have an affirmative duty to disclose any potential conflict of interest known to them that exists between the Firm and the client on whose behalf the proxy is to be voted (“Conflict”).

8.2. By way of example, Conflicts may exist in situations where the Firm is called to vote on a proxy involving an issuer or proponent of a proxy proposal regarding the issuer where MacKay Shields or an affiliated person of the Firm also:

 

   

Manages the issuer’s or proponent’s pension plan;

 

   

Administers the issuer’s or proponent’s employee benefit plan;

 

   

Provided brokerage, underwriting, insurance or banking services to the issuer or proponent; or

 

   

Manages money for an employee group.

 

B-22


Table of Contents

 

Additional Conflicts may exist, among others, if an executive of the Firm or its control affiliates is a close relative of, or has a personal or business relationship with:

 

   

An executive of the issuer or proponent;

 

   

A director of the issuer or proponent;

 

   

A person who is a candidate to be a director of the issuer;

 

   

A participant in the proxy contest; or

 

   

A proponent of a proxy proposal.

8.3 Whether a relationship creates a Conflict will depend on the facts and circumstances. Even if these parties do not attempt to influence the Firm with respect to voting, the value of the relationship to MacKay Shields or an affiliate can create a Conflict.

8.4 After a Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form is completed pursuant to Sections 6 or 7, such Form, which elicits information as to whether a potential Conflict exists, must be submitted to the Legal/Compliance Department for review. If the Firm’s General Counsel (“GC”) or Chief Compliance Officer (“CCO”) determines that there is no potential Conflict, the GC or CCO or their designee may instruct RM to vote the proxy issue as set forth in the completed Form.

8.5 If the GC or CCO determines that there exists or may exist a Conflict, he or she will refer the issue to the Compliance Committee for consideration by convening (in person or via telephone) an emergency meeting of the Compliance Committee. For purposes of this Policy, a majority vote of those members present shall resolve any Conflict. The Compliance Committee will consider the facts and circumstances of the pending proxy vote and the potential or actual Conflict and make a determination as to how to vote the proxy — i.e., whether to permit or deny the recommendation of the portfolio manager, or whether to take other action, such as delegating the proxy vote to an independent third party or obtaining voting instructions from clients.

8.6 In considering the proxy vote and potential Conflict, the Compliance Committee may review the following factors, including but not limited to:

 

   

The percentage of outstanding securities of the issuer held on behalf of clients by the Firm.

 

   

The nature of the relationship of the issuer with the Firm, its affiliates or its executive officers.

 

   

Whether there has been any attempt to directly or indirectly influence the portfolio manager’s decision.

 

   

Whether the direction (for or against) of the proposed vote would appear to benefit the Firm or a related party.

 

   

Whether an objective decision to vote in a certain way will still create a strong appearance of a Conflict.

MacKay Shields may not abstain from voting any such proxy for the purpose of avoiding Conflict.

9. Securities Lending

MacKay Shields portfolio managers will monitor upcoming meetings and MacKay Shields will request that clients call back securities loans, if applicable, in anticipation of an important vote to be taken among holders of the securities or of the giving or withholding of their consent on a material matter affecting the investment. In determining whether to request that clients call back securities loans, the relevant portfolio manager(s) shall consider whether the benefit to the client in voting the matter outweighs the benefit to the client in keeping the security on loan.

 

B-23


Table of Contents

 

10. Reporting

Upon request, MacKay Shields shall report annually (or more frequently if specifically requested) to its clients on proxy votes cast on their behalf. MacKay Shields will provide any client who makes a written or verbal request with a copy of a report disclosing how MacKay Shields voted securities held in that client’s portfolio. The report will generally contain the following information:

 

   

The name of the issuer of the security;

 

   

The security’s exchange ticker symbol;

 

   

The security’s CUSIP number;

 

   

The shareholder meeting date;

 

   

A brief identification of the matter voted on;

 

   

Whether the matter was proposed by the issuer or by a security holder;

 

   

Whether MacKay Shields cast its vote on the matter;

 

   

How MacKay Shields voted; and

 

   

Whether MacKay Shields voted for or against management.

11. Record-Keeping

Either MacKay Shields or RM as indicated below will maintain the following records:

 

   

A copy of the Policy and MacKay’s Standard Guidelines;

 

   

A copy of each proxy statement received by MacKay Shields or forwarded to RM by the client’s custodian regarding client securities;

 

   

A record of each vote cast by MacKay Shields on behalf of a client;

 

   

A copy of all documents created by MacKay Shields that were material to making a decision on the proxy voting (or abstaining from voting) of client securities or that memorialize the basis for that decision including the resolution of any Conflict, a copy of all guideline override requests and all supporting documents; and

 

   

A copy of each written request by a client for information on how MacKay Shields voted proxies on behalf of the client, as well as a copy of any written response by MacKay Shields to any request by a client for information on how MacKay Shields voted proxies on behalf of the client; records of oral requests for information or oral responses will not be kept.

Such records must be maintained for at least eight years.

12. Review of Voting and Guidelines

As part of its periodic reviews, MacKay Shields’ Legal/Compliance Department will conduct an annual review of the prior year’s proxy voting as well as the guidelines established for proxy voting. Documentation shall be maintained of this review and a report setting forth the results of the review will be presented annually to the Compliance Committee.

 

B-24


Table of Contents

 

13. How to Request Information On How the Firm Voted Proxies

Clients may, at anytime, request and receive information from MacKay Shields as to how the Firm voted proxies for securities held in their account. Any such proxy information request should be in writing and mailed or faxed [(212)-754-9205] to MacKay Shields Client Services Department at:

MacKay Shields LLC

9 West 57th Street

New York, NY 10019

ATTN: Client Services

Attachments:

 

Exhibit A—

   Summary of Standard Guidelines for non-union clients

Exhibit B—

   Summary of Standard Guidelines for union clients (Taft-Hartley)

Schedule C—

   Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form

 

Effective February 12, 2010

 

B-25


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 

2010 U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines Summary

January 8, 2010

 

 

Copyright © 2009-2010 by RiskMetrics Group.

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.

Risk Management  |  RiskMetrics Labs  |  ISS Governance Services  |  Financial Research & Analysis

www.riskmetrics.com


Table of Contents

 

RiskMetrics Group

2010 U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines Summary

Effective for Meetings on or after Feb. 1, 2010

Published December 31, 2009

Updated Jan. 8, 2010

The following is a condensed version of the proxy voting recommendations contained in the RiskMetrics’ (RMG) U.S. Proxy Voting Manual.

 

Table of Contents

  

TABLE OF CONTENTS

     B-27   

1. ROUTINE/MISCELLANEOUS

     B-32   

Adjourn Meeting

     B-32   

Amend Quorum Requirements

     B-32   

Amend Minor Bylaws

     B-32   

Change Company Name

     B-32   

Change Date, Time, or Location of Annual Meeting

     B-32   

Other Business

     B-32   

Audit-Related

     B-32   

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

     B-32   

Auditor Ratification

     B-33   

Shareholder Proposals Limiting Non-Audit Services

     B-33   

Shareholder Proposals on Audit Firm Rotation

     B-33   

2. BOARD OF DIRECTORS:

     B-34   

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

     B-34   

Board Accountability

     B-34   

Problematic Takeover Defenses

     B-34   

Problematic Audit-Related Practices

     B-35   

Problematic Compensation Practices

     B-35   

Other Problematic Governance Practices

     B-36   

Board Responsiveness

     B-36   

Director Independence

     B-37   

Director Competence

     B-37   

2010 RMG Categorization of Directors

     B-37   

Board-Related Management Proposals

     B-40   

Age Limits

     B-40   

Board Size

     B-40   

Classification/Declassification of the Board

     B-40   

Cumulative Voting

     B-40   

Director and Officer Indemnification and Liability Protection

     B-40   

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

     B-41   

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

     B-41   

Majority Vote Threshold for Director Elections

     B-41   

Term Limits

     B-41   

Board-Related Shareholder Proposals/Initiatives

     B-41   

Age Limits

     B-41   

Annual Election (Declassification) of the Board

     B-41   

 

B-27


Table of Contents

Cumulative Voting

     B-42   

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

     B-42   

Establishment of Board Committees Shareholder Proposals

     B-42   

Establishment of Board Policy on Shareholder Engagement

     B-42   

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

     B-43   

Independent Chair (Separate Chair/CEO)

     B-43   

Majority of Independent Directors/Establishment of Independent Committees

     B-44   

Majority Vote Shareholder Proposals

     B-44   

Open Access (Proxy Access)

     B-44   

Proxy Contests- Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

     B-45   

Require More Nominees than Open Seats

     B-45   

Term Limits

     B-45   

Vote No Campaigns

     B-45   

3. SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS & DEFENSES

     B-45   

Advance Notice Requirements for Shareholder Proposals/Nominations

     B-45   

Amend Bylaws without Shareholder Consent

     B-46   

Confidential Voting

     B-46   

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

     B-46   

Control Share Cash-Out Provisions

     B-46   

Disgorgement Provisions

     B-47   

Fair Price Provisions

     B-47   

Freeze-Out Provisions

     B-47   

Greenmail

     B-47   

Net Operating Loss (NOL) Protective Amendments

     B-47   

Poison Pills- Shareholder Proposals to put Pill to a Vote and/or Adopt a Pill Policy

     B-48   

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to Ratify Poison Pill

     B-48   

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to ratify a Pill to preserve Net Operating Losses (NOLs)

     B-49   

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

     B-49   

Reincorporation Proposals

     B-49   

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

     B-50   

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

     B-50   

Stakeholder Provisions

     B-50   

State Antitakeover Statutes

     B-50   

Supermajority Vote Requirements

     B-51   

4. CAPITAL/RESTRUCTURING

     B-51   

Capital

     B-51   

Adjustments to Par Value of Common Stock

     B-51   

Common Stock Authorization

     B-51   

Issue Stock for Use with Rights Plan

     B-51   

Preemptive Rights

     B-52   

Preferred Stock

     B-52   

Recapitalization

     B-52   

Reverse Stock Splits

     B-52   

Share Repurchase Programs

     B-53   

Stock Distributions: Splits and Dividends

     B-53   

Tracking Stock

     B-53   

Restructuring

     B-53   

Appraisal Rights

     B-53   

Asset Purchases

     B-53   

Asset Sales

     B-54   

 

B-28


Table of Contents

Bundled Proposals

     B-54   

Conversion of Securities

     B-54   

Corporate Reorganization/Debt Restructuring/Prepackaged Bankruptcy Plans/Reverse Leveraged Buyouts/Wrap Plans

     B-54   

Formation of Holding Company

     B-55   

Going Private and Going Dark Transactions (LBOs and Minority Squeeze-outs)

     B-55   

Joint Ventures

     B-56   

Liquidations

     B-56   

Mergers and Acquisitions

     B-56   

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

     B-57   

Private Placements/Warrants/Convertible Debentures

     B-57   

Special Purpose Acquisition Corporations (SPACs)

     B-58   

Spinoffs

     B-59   

Value Maximization Shareholder Proposals

     B-59   

5. COMPENSATION

     B-60   

Executive Pay Evaluation

     B-60   

Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation- Management Proposals (Management Say-on-Pay)

     B-60   

Pay for Performance

     B-61   

Problematic Pay Practices

     B-62   

Non-Performance based Compensation Elements

     B-62   

Incentives that may Motivate Excessive Risk-Taking

     B-62   

Options Backdating

     B-63   

Board Communications and Responsiveness

     B-63   

Equity-Based and Other Incentive Plans

     B-64   

Cost of Equity Plans

     B-64   

Repricing Provisions

     B-64   

Three-Year Burn Rate/Burn Rate Commitment

     B-65   

Burn Rate Table for 2010

     B-65   

Pay-for-Performance- Impact on Equity Plans

     B-66   

Liberal Definition of Change-in-Control

     B-66   

Problematic Pay Practices

     B-66   

Specific Treatment of Certain Award Types in Equity Plan Evaluations:

     B-66   

Dividend Equivalent Rights

     B-66   

Liberal Share Recycling Provisions

     B-66   

Operating Partnership (OP) units in Equity Plan analysis of Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

     B-67   

Option Overhang Cost

     B-67   

Other Compensation Plans

     B-68   

401(k) Employee Benefit Plans

     B-68   

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

     B-68   

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Qualified Plans

     B-68   

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Non-Qualified Plans

     B-68   

Incentive Bonus Plans and Tax Deductibility Proposals (OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals)

     B-68   

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

     B-69   

Stock Plans in Lieu of Cash

     B-69   

Transfer Stock Option (TSO) Programs

     B-70   

Director Compensation

     B-70   

Equity Plans for Non-Employee Directors

     B-70   

Director Retirement Plans

     B-71   

 

B-29


Table of Contents

Shareholder Proposals on Compensation

     B-71   

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay)

     B-71   

Compensation Consultants- Disclosure of Board or Company’s Utilization

     B-71   

Disclosure/Setting Levels or Types of Compensation for Executives and Directors

     B-71   

Golden Coffins/Executive Death Benefits

     B-72   

Pay for Superior Performance

     B-72   

Performance-Based Awards

     B-73   

Pension Plan Income Accounting

     B-73   

Pre-Arranged Trading Plans (10b5-1 Plans)

     B-73   

Recoup Bonuses

     B-73   

Severance Agreements for Executives/Golden Parachutes

     B-74   

Share Buyback Holding Periods

     B-74   

Stock Ownership or Holding Period Guidelines

     B-74   

Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans (SERPs)

     B-75   

Termination of Employment Prior to Severance Payment and Eliminating Accelerated Vesting of Unvested Equity

     B-75   

Tax Gross-Up Proposals

     B-75   

6. SOCIAL/ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES

     B-76   

Overall Approach

     B-76   

Animal Welfare

     B-76   

Animal Testing

     B-76   

Animal Welfare Policies

     B-76   

Controlled Atmosphere Killing (CAK)

     B-77   

Consumer Issues

     B-77   

Genetically Modified Ingredients

     B-77   

Consumer Lending

     B-77   

Pharmaceutical Pricing, Access to Medicines, and Product Reimportation

     B-78   

Product Safety and Toxic/Hazardous Materials

     B-78   

Tobacco

     B-79   

Diversity

     B-79   

Board Diversity

     B-79   

Equality of Opportunity

     B-80   

Gender Identity, Sexual Orientation, and Domestic Partner Benefits

     B-80   

Climate Change and the Environment

     B-80   

Climate Change

     B-80   

Concentrated Animal Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

     B-80   

Energy Efficiency

     B-81   

Facility and Operational Safety/Security

     B-81   

Greenhouse Gas (GHG) Emissions

     B-81   

Operations in Protected Areas

     B-82   

Recycling

     B-82   

Renewable Energy

     B-82   

General Corporate Issues

     B-82   

Charitable Contributions

     B-82   

Environmental, Social, and Governance (ESG) Compensation-Related Proposals

     B-83   

Health Pandemics

     B-83   

Lobbying Expenditures/Initiatives

     B-83   

Political Contributions and Trade Associations Spending

     B-84   

 

B-30


Table of Contents

International Issues, Labor Issues, and Human Rights

     B-84   

Community Social and Environmental Impact Assessments

     B-84   

Foreign Military Sales/Offsets

     B-85   

Internet Privacy and Censorship

     B-85   

Labor and Human Rights Standards

     B-85   

MacBride Principles

     B-86   

Nuclear and Depleted Uranium Weapons

     B-86   

Operations in High Risk Markets

     B-86   

Outsourcing/Offshoring

     B-86   

Sustainability

     B-87   

Sustainability Reporting

     B-87   

7. MUTUAL FUND PROXIES

     B-87   

Election of Directors

     B-87   

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund

     B-87   

Proxy Contests

     B-87   

Investment Advisory Agreements

     B-88   

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares

     B-88   

Preferred Stock Proposals

     B-88   

1940 Act Policies

     B-88   

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Nonfundamental Restriction

     B-89   

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Nonfundamental

     B-89   

Name Change Proposals

     B-89   

Change in Fund’s Subclassification

     B-89   

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation

     B-89   

Changes to the Charter Document

     B-90   

Changing the Domicile of a Fund

     B-90   

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval

     B-90   

Distribution Agreements

     B-90   

Master-Feeder Structure

     B-91   

Mergers

     B-91   

Shareholder Proposals for Mutual Funds

     B-91   

Establish Director Ownership Requirement

     B-91   

Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred

     B-91   

Terminate the Investment Advisor

     B-91   

 

B-31


Table of Contents

 

1. Routine/Miscellaneous

Adjourn Meeting

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to provide management with the authority to adjourn an annual or special meeting absent compelling reasons to support the proposal.

Vote FOR proposals that relate specifically to soliciting votes for a merger or transaction if supporting that merger or transaction. Vote AGAINST proposals if the wording is too vague or if the proposal includes “other business.”

Amend Quorum Requirements

Vote AGAINST proposals to reduce quorum requirements for shareholder meetings below a majority of the shares outstanding unless there are compelling reasons to support the proposal.

Amend Minor Bylaws

Vote FOR bylaw or charter changes that are of a housekeeping nature (updates or corrections).

Change Company Name

Vote FOR proposals to change the corporate name.

Change Date, Time, or Location of Annual Meeting

Vote FOR management proposals to change the date, time, and/or location of the annual meeting unless the proposed change is unreasonable.

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to change the date, time, and/or location of the annual meeting unless the current scheduling or location is unreasonable.

Other Business

Vote AGAINST proposals to approve other business when it appears as voting item.

Audit-Related

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

Consider the issue of auditor indemnification and limitation of liability on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Factors to be assessed include, but are not limited to:

 

   

The terms of the auditor agreement- the degree to which these agreements impact shareholders’ rights;

 

B-32


Table of Contents
   

Motivation and rationale for establishing the agreements;

 

   

Quality of disclosure; and

 

   

Historical practices in the audit area.

WITHHOLD or vote AGAINST members of an audit committee in situations where there is persuasive evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.

Auditor Ratification

Vote FOR proposals to ratify auditors, unless any of the following apply:

 

   

An auditor has a financial interest in or association with the company, and is therefore not independent;

 

   

There is reason to believe that the independent auditor has rendered an opinion which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

 

   

Poor accounting practices are identified that rise to a serious level of concern, such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures; or

 

   

Fees for non-audit services (“Other” fees) are excessive.

Non-audit fees are excessive if:

 

   

Non-audit (“other”) fees > audit fees + audit related fees + tax compliance/preparation fees

Tax compliance and preparation include the preparation of original and amended tax returns, refund claims and tax payment planning. All other services in the tax category, such as tax advice, planning or consulting should be added “Other” fees. If the breakout of tax fees cannot be determined, add all tax fees to “Other “ fees.

In circumstances where “Other” fees include fees related to significant one-time capital structure events: initial public offerings, bankruptcy emergence, and spin-offs; and the company makes public disclosure of the amount and nature of those fees which are an exception to the standard “non-audit fee” category, then such fees may be excluded from the non-audit fees considered in determining the ratio of non-audit to audit/audit-related fees/tax compliance and preparation for purposes of determining whether non-audit fees are excessive.

Shareholder Proposals Limiting Non-Audit Services

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking companies to prohibit or limit their auditors from engaging in non-audit services.

Shareholder Proposals on Audit Firm Rotation

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking for audit firm rotation, taking into account:

 

   

The tenure of the audit firm;

 

   

The length of rotation specified in the proposal;

 

   

Any significant audit-related issues at the company;

 

   

The number of Audit Committee meetings held each year;

 

B-33


Table of Contents

 

   

The number of financial experts serving on the committee; and

 

   

Whether the company has a periodic renewal process where the auditor is evaluated for both audit quality and competitive price.

2. Board of Directors:

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

Votes on director nominees should be determined on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Four fundamental principles apply when determining votes on director nominees:

 

   

Board Accountability: Practices that promote accountability include: transparency into a company’s governance practices; annual board elections; and providing shareholders the ability to remove problematic directors and to vote on takeover defenses or other charter/bylaw amendments. These practices help reduce the opportunity for management entrenchment.

 

   

Board Responsiveness: Directors should be responsive to shareholders, particularly in regard to shareholder proposals that receive a majority vote and to tender offers where a majority of shares are tendered. Furthermore, shareholders should expect directors to devote sufficient time and resources to oversight of the company.

 

   

Director Independence: Without independence from management, the board may be unwilling or unable to effectively set company strategy and scrutinize performance or executive compensation.

 

   

Director Competence: Companies should seek directors who can add value to the board through specific skills or expertise and who can devote sufficient time and commitment to serve effectively. While directors should not be constrained by arbitrary limits such as age or term limits, directors who are unable to attend board and committee meetings and/or who are overextended (i.e. serving on too many boards) raise concern on the director’s ability to effectively serve in shareholders’ best interests.

Board Accountability

Problematic Takeover Defenses

VOTE WITHHOLD/AGAINST1 the entire board of directors (except new nominees2, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis), if:

 

   

The board is classified, and a continuing director responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote recommendation is not up for election — any or all appropriate nominees (except new) may be held accountable;

 

   

The company’s poison pill has a “dead-hand” or “modified dead-hand feature. Vote withhold/against every year until this feature is removed;

 

 

1

In general, companies with a plurality vote standard use “withhold” as the valid contrary vote option in director elections; companies with a majority vote standard use “Against”. However, it will vary by company and the proxy must be checked to determine the valid contrary vote option for the particular company.

2

A “new nominee” is any current nominee who has not already been elected by shareholders and who joined the board after the problematic action in question transpired. If RMG cannot determine whether the nominee joined the board before or after the problematic action transpired, the nominee will be considered a “new nominee” if he or she joined the board within the 12 months prior to the upcoming shareholder meeting.

 

B-34


Table of Contents

 

   

The board adopts a poison pill with -term aterm pill”), of existing pill, including any “short-term” pill (12 months or less), commitment or policy that puts a newly-adopted pill to a binding shareholder vote may potentially offset an adverse vote recommendation. Review such companies with classified boards every year, and such companies with annually-elected boards at least once every three years, and vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees if the company still maintains a non-shareholder-approved poison pill. This policy applies to all companies adopting or renewing pills after the announcement of this policy (Nov 19, 2009);

 

   

The board makes a material adverse change to an existing poison pill without shareholder approval.

Vote CASE-By-CASE on all nominees if the board adopts a poison pill with a term of 12 months or less (“short-term pill”) without shareholder approval, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

The date of the pill’s adoption relative to the date of the next meeting of shareholders- i.e. whether the company had time to put the pill on ballot for shareholder ratification given the circumstances;

 

   

The issuer’s rationale;

 

   

The issuer’s governance structure and practices; and

 

   

The issuer’s track record of accountability to shareholders.

Problematic Audit-Related Practices

Generally, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from the members of the Audit Committee if:

 

   

The non-audit fees paid to the auditor are excessive (see discussion under “Auditor Ratification”);

 

   

The company receives an adverse opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditor; or

 

   

There is persuasive evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.

Vote CASE-by-CASE on members of the Audit Committee and/or the full board if:

 

   

Poor accounting practices are identified that rise to a level of serious concern, such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures. Examine the severity, breadth, chronological sequence and duration, as the company’s efforts at remediation or corrective actions, in determining whether WITHHOLD/AGAINST votes are warranted.

Problematic Compensation Practices

VOTE WITHHOLD/AGAINST the members of the Compensation Committee and potentially the full board if:

 

   

There is a negative correlation between chief executive pay and company performance (see Pay for Performance Policy);

 

   

The company reprices underwater options for stock, cash, or other consideration without prior shareholder approval, even if allowed in the firm’s equity plan;

 

   

The company fails to submit one-time transfers of stock options to a shareholder vote;

 

   

The company fails to fulfill the terms of a burn rate commitment made to shareholders;

 

   

The company has problematic pay practices. Problematic pay practices may warrant withholding votes from the CEO and potentially the entire board as well.

 

B-35


Table of Contents

 

Other Problematic Governance Practices

VOTE WITHHOLD/AGAINST the entire board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis), if:

 

   

The company’s proxy indicates that not all directors attended 75 percent of the aggregate board and committee meetings, but fails to provide the required disclosure of the names of the director(s) involved. If this information cannot be obtained, withhold from all incumbent directors;

 

   

The board lacks accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers. Sustained poor performance is measured by one- and three-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). Take into consideration the company’s five-year total shareholder return and five-year operational metrics. Problematic provisions include but are not limited to:

 

  A classified board structure;

 

  A supermajority vote requirement;

 

  Majority vote standard for director elections with no carve out for contested elections;

 

  The inability for shareholders to call special meetings;

 

  The inability for shareholders to act by written consent;

 

  A dual-class structure; and/or

 

  A non-shareholder approved poison pill.

Under extraordinary circumstances, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from directors individually, committee members, or the entire board, due to:

 

   

Material failures of governance, stewardship, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company;

 

   

Failure to replace management as appropriate; or

 

   

Egregious actions related to the director(s) service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.

Board Responsiveness

Vote WITHHOLD/AGAINST the entire board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis), if:

 

   

The board failed to act on a shareholder proposal that received approval by a majority of the shares outstanding the previous year (a management proposal with other than a FOR recommendation by management will not be considered as sufficient action taken);

 

   

The board failed to act on a shareholder proposal that received approval of the majority of shares cast for the previous two consecutive years (a management proposal with other than a FOR recommendation by management will not be considered as sufficient action taken);

 

   

The board failed to act on takeover offers where the majority of the shareholders tendered their shares; or

 

   

At the previous board election, any director received more than 50 percent withhold/against votes of the shares cast and the company has failed to address the issue(s) that caused the high withhold/against vote.

 

B-36


Table of Contents

 

Director Independence

Vote WITHHOLD/AGAINST Inside Directors and Affiliated Outside Directors (per the Categorization of Directors) when:

 

   

The inside or affiliated outside director serves on any of the three key committees: audit, compensation, or nominating;

 

   

The company lacks an audit, compensation, or nominating committee so that the full board functions as that committee;

 

   

The company lacks a formal nominating committee, even if the board attests that the independent directors fulfill the functions of such a committee; or

 

   

The full board is less than majority independent.

Director Competence

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from individual directors who:

 

   

Attend less than 75 percent of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse, such as illness, service to the nation, work on behalf of the company, or funeral obligations. If the company provides meaningful public or private disclosure explaining the director’s absences, evaluate the information on a CASE-BY-CASE basis taking into account the following factors:

 

  Degree to which absences were due to an unavoidable conflict;

 

  Pattern of absenteeism; and

 

  Other extraordinary circumstances underlying the director’s absence;

 

   

Sit on more than six public company boards;

 

   

Are CEOs of public companies who sit on the boards of more than two public companies besides their own — withhold only at their outside boards.

2010 RMG Categorization of Directors

 

1. Inside Director (I)

 

  1.1.

Employee of the company or one of its affiliatesi.

 

  1.2. Among the five most highly paid individuals (excluding interim CEO).

 

  1.3.

Listed as an officer as defined under Section 16 of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 (“section 16 officer”)ii.

 

  1.4. Current interim CEO.

 

  1.5. Beneficial owner of more than 50 percent of the company’s voting power (this may be aggregated if voting power is distributed among more than one member of a defined group).

 

2. Affiliated Outside Director (AO)

Board Attestation

 

  2.1. Board attestation that an outside director is not independent.

Former CEO

 

  2.2.

Former CEO of the companyiii,iv.

 

  2.3.

Former CEO of an acquired company within the past five yearsiv.

 

B-37


Table of Contents

 

  2.4.

Former interim CEO if the service was longer than 18 months. If the service was between twelve and eighteen months an assessment of the interim CEO’s employment agreement will be madev.

Non-CEO Executives

 

  2.5.

Former Section 16 officerii of the company, an affiliatei or an acquired firm within the past five years.

 

  2.6.

Section 16 officerii of a former parent or predecessor firm at the time the company was sold or split off from the parent/predecessor within the past five years.

 

  2.7.

Section 16 officerii, former Section 16 officer, or general or limited partner of a joint venture or partnership with the company.

Family Members

 

  2.8.

Immediate family membervi of a current or former Section 16 officerii of the company or its affiliatesi within the last five years.

 

  2.9.

Immediate family membervi of a current employee of company or its affiliatesi where additional factors raise concern (which may include, but are not limited to, the following: a director related to numerous employees; the company or its affiliates employ relatives of numerous board members; or a non-Section 16 officer in a key strategic role).

Transactional, Professional, Financial, and Charitable Relationships

 

  2.10.

Currently provides (or an immediate family membervi provides) professional servicesvii to the company, to an affiliatei of the company or an individual officer of the company or one of its affiliates in excess of $10,000 per year.

 

  2.11.

Is (or an immediate family membervi is) a partner in, or a controlling shareholder or an employee of, an organization which provides professional servicesvii to the company, to an affiliatei of the company, or an individual officer of the company or one of its affiliates in excess of $10,000 per year.

 

  2.12.

Has (or an immediate family membervi has) any material transactional relationshipviii with the company or its affiliatesi (excluding investments in the company through a private placement).

 

  2.13.

Is (or an immediate family membervi is) a partner in, or a controlling shareholder or an executive officer of, an organization which has any material transactional relationshipviii with the company or its affiliatesi (excluding investments in the company through a private placement).

 

  2.14.

Is (or an immediate family membervi is) a trustee, director, or employee of a charitable or non-profit organization that receives material grants or endowmentsviii from the company or its affiliatesi.

Other Relationships

 

  2.15.

Party to a voting agreementix to vote in line with management on proposals being brought to shareholder vote.

 

  2.16.

Has (or an immediate family membervi has) an interlocking relationship as defined by the SEC involving members of the board of directors or its Compensation Committeex.

 

  2.17.

Founderxi of the company but not currently an employee.

 

  2.18.

Any materialxii relationship with the company.

 

3. Independent Outside Director (IO)

 

  3.1.

No materialxii connection to the company other than a board seat.

Footnotes:

i

“Affiliate” includes a subsidiary, sibling company, or the parent company. RMG uses 50 percent control ownership by the parent company as the standard for applying its affiliate designation.

 

B-38


Table of Contents
ii

“Section 16 officer” (officers subject to Section 16 of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934) includes the chief executive, operating, financial, legal, technology, and accounting officers of a company (including the president, treasurer, secretary, controller, or any vice president in charge of a principal business unit, division, or policy function). A non-employee director serving as an officer due to statutory requirements (e.g. corporate secretary) will be classified as an Affiliated Outsider. If the company provides explicit disclosure that the director is not receiving additional compensation in excess of $10,000 per year for serving in that capacity, then the director will be classified as an Independent Outsider.

iii

Includes any former CEO of the company prior to the company’s initial public offering (IPO).

iv

When there is a former CEO of a special purpose acquisition company (SPAC) serving on the board of an acquired company, RMG will generally classify such directors as independent unless determined otherwise taking into account the following factors: the applicable listing standards determination of such director’s independence; any operating ties to the firm; and the existence of any other conflicting relationships or related party transactions.

v

RMG will look at the terms of the interim CEO’s employment contract to determine if it contains serverance pay, long-term health and pension benefits, or other such standard provisions typically contained in contracts of permanent, non-temporary CEOs. RMG will also consider if a formal search process was underway for a full-time CEO at the time.

vi

“Immediate family member” follows the SEC’s definition of such and cover spouses, parents, children, step-parents, step-children, siblings, in-laws, and any person (other than a tenant or employee) sharing the household of any director, nominee for director, executive officer, or significant shareholder of the company.

vii

Professional services can be characterized as advisory in nature, generally involve access to sensitive company information or to strategic decision-making, and typically have a commission- or fee-based payment structure. Professional services generally include, but are not limited to the following: investment banking/financial advisory services; commercial banking (beyond deposit services); investment services; insurance services; accounting/audit services; consulting services; marketing services; legal services; property management services; realtor services; lobbying services; executive search services; and IT consulting services. The following would generally be considered transactional relationships and not professional services: deposit services; IT tech support services; educational services; and construction services. The case of participation in a banking syndicate by a non-lead bank should be considered a transactional (and hence subject to the associated materiality test) rather than a professional relationship. “Of Counsel” relationships are only considered immaterial if the individual does not receive any form of compensation (in excess of $10,000 per year) from, or is a retired partner of, the firm providing the professional service. The case of a company providing a professional service to one of its directors or to an entity with which one of its directors is affiliated, will be considered a transactional rather than a professional relationship. Insurance services and marketing services are assumed to be professional services unless the company explains why such services are not advisory.

viii

A material transactional relationship, including grants to non-profit organizations, exists if the company makes annual payments to, or receives annual payments from, another entity exceeding the greater of $200,000 or 5 percent of the recipient’s gross revenues, in the case of a company which follows NASDAQ listing standards; or the greater of $1,000,000 or 2 percent of the recipient’s gross revenues, in the case of a company which follows NYSE/Amex listing standards. In the case of a company which follows neither of the preceding standards, RMG will apply the NASDAQ-based materiality test. (The recipient is the party receiving the financial proceeds from the transaction).

ix

Dissident directors who are parties to a voting agreement pursuant to a settlement arrangement, will generally be classified as independent unless determined otherwise taking into account the following factors: the terms of the agreement; the duration of the standstill provision in the agreement; the limitations and requirements of actions that are agreed upon; if the dissident director nominee(s) is subject to the standstill; and if there any conflicting relationships or related party transactions.

x

Interlocks include: executive officers serving as directors on each other’s compensation or similar committees (or, in the absence of such a committee, on the board); or executive officers sitting on each other’s boards and at least one serves on the other’s compensation or similar committees (or in the absence of such a committee on the board).

 

B-39


Table of Contents
xi

The operating involvement of the founder with the company will be considered. Little to no operating involvement may cause RMG to deem the founder as an independent outsider.

xii

For purposes of RMG’s director independence classification, “material” will be defined as a standard of relationship (financial, personal or otherwise) that a reasonable person might conclude could potentially influence one’s objectivity in the boardroom in a manner that would have a meaningful impact on an individual’s ability to satisfy requisite fiduciary standards on behalf of shareholders.

Board-Related Management Proposals

Age Limits

Vote AGAINST management proposal to limit the tenure of outside directors through mandatory retirement ages.

Board Size

Vote FOR proposals seeking to fix the board size or designate a range for the board size.

Vote AGAINST proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board outside of a specified range without shareholder approval.

Classification/Declassification of the Board

Vote AGAINST proposals to classify (stagger) the board.

Vote FOR proposals to repeal classified boards and to elect all directors annually.

Cumulative Voting

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to eliminate cumulative voting.

Director and Officer Indemnification and Liability Protection

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals on director and officer indemnification and liability protection using Delaware law as the standard.

Vote AGAINST proposals to eliminate entirely directors’ and officers’ liability for monetary damages for violating the duty of care.

Vote AGAINST indemnification proposals that would expand coverage beyond just legal expenses to liability for acts, such as negligence, that are more serious violations of fiduciary obligation than mere carelessness.

Vote AGAINST proposals that would expand the scope of indemnification to provide for mandatory indemnification of company officials in connection with acts that previously the company was permitted to provide indemnification for at the discretion of the company’s board (i.e., “permissive indemnification”) but that previously the company was not required to indemnify.

 

B-40


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR only those proposals providing such expanded coverage in cases when a director’s or officer’s legal defense was unsuccessful if both of the following apply:

 

   

If the director was found to have acted in good faith and in a manner that he reasonably believed was in the best interests of the company; and

 

   

If only the director’s legal expenses would be covered.

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals that establish or amend director qualifications. Votes should be based on how reasonable the criteria are and to what degree they may preclude dissident nominees from joining the board.

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause.

Vote FOR proposals to restore shareholders’ ability to remove directors with or without cause.

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

Vote FOR proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

Majority Vote Threshold for Director Elections

Generally vote FOR management proposals to adopt a majority of votes cast standard for directors in uncontested elections. Vote AGAINST if no carve-out for plurality in contested elections is included.

Term Limits

Vote AGAINST management proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors through term limits. However, scrutinize boards where the average tenure of all directors exceeds 15 years for independence from management and for sufficient turnover to ensure that new perspectives are being added to the board.

Board-Related Shareholder Proposals/Initiatives

Age Limits

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors through mandatory retirement ages.

Annual Election (Declassification) of the Board

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to repeal classified (staggered) boards and to elect all directors annually.

 

B-41


Table of Contents

 

Cumulative Voting

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals to restore or provide for cumulative voting unless:

 

   

The company has proxy access or a similar structure3 to allow shareholders to nominate directors to the company’s ballot; and

 

   

The company has adopted a majority vote standard, with a carve-out for plurality voting in situations where there are more nominees than seats, and a director resignation policy to address failed elections.

Vote FOR proposals for cumulative voting at controlled companies (insider voting power > 50%).

Establish/Amend Nominee Qualifications

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals that establish or amend director qualifications. Votes should be based on the reasonableness of the criteria and to what degree they may preclude dissident nominees from joining the board.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder resolutions seeking a director nominee candidate who possesses a particular subject matter expertise, considering:

 

   

The company’s board committee structure, existing subject matter expertise, and board nomination provisions relative to that of its peers;

 

   

The company’s existing board and management oversight mechanisms regarding the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

The company disclosure and performance relating to the issue for which board oversight is sought and any significant related controversies; and

 

   

The scope and structure of the proposal.

Establishment of Board Committees Shareholder Proposals

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to establish a new board committee, as such proposals seek a specific oversight mechanism/structure that potentially limits a company’s flexibility to determine an appropriate oversight mechanism for itself. However, the following factors will be considered:

 

   

Existing oversight mechanisms (including current committee structure) regarding the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

Level of disclosure regarding the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

Company performance related to the issue for which board oversight is sought;

 

   

Board committee structure compared to that of other companies in its industry sector; and/or

 

   

The scope and structure of the proposal.

Establishment of Board Policy on Shareholder Engagement

Generally vote FOR shareholders proposals requesting that the board establish an internal mechanism/process, which may include a committee, in order to improve communications between directors and shareholders, unless the company has the following features, as appropriate:

 

   

Established a communication structure that goes beyond the exchange requirements to facilitate the exchange of information between shareholders and members of the board;

 

 

3

Similar structure” would be a structure that allows shareholders to nominate candidates who the company will include on the management ballot IN ADDITION TO management’s nominees, and their bios are included in management’s proxy.

 

B-42


Table of Contents
   

Effectively disclosed information with respect to this structure to its shareholders;

 

   

Company has not ignored majority-supported shareholder proposals or a majority withhold vote on a director nominee; and

 

   

The company has an independent chairman or a lead director, according to RMG’s definition. This individual must be made available for periodic consultation and direct communication with major shareholders.

Filling Vacancies/Removal of Directors

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause.

Vote FOR proposals to restore shareholders’ ability to remove directors with or without cause.

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

Vote FOR proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

Independent Chair (Separate Chair/CEO)

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requiring that the chairman’s position be filled by an independent director, unless the company satisfies all of the following criteria:

The company maintains the following counterbalancing governance structure:

 

   

Designated lead director, elected by and from the independent board members with clearly delineated and comprehensive duties. (The role may alternatively reside with a presiding director, vice chairman, or rotating lead director; however the director must serve a minimum of one year in order to qualify as a lead director.) The duties should include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

  presides at all meetings of the board at which the chairman is not present, including executive sessions of the independent directors;

 

  serves as liaison between the chairman and the independent directors;

 

  approves information sent to the board;

 

  approves meeting agendas for the board;

 

  approves meeting schedules to assure that there is sufficient time for discussion of all agenda items;

 

  has the authority to call meetings of the independent directors;

 

  if requested by major shareholders, ensures that he is available for consultation and direct communication;

 

   

Two-thirds independent board;

 

   

All independent key committees;

 

   

Established governance guidelines;

 

   

A company in the Russell 3000 universe must not have exhibited sustained poor total shareholder return (TSR) performance, defined as one- and three-year TSR in the bottom half of the company’s

 

B-43


Table of Contents
 

four-digit GICS industry group (using Russell 3000 companies only), unless there has been a change in the Chairman/CEO position within that time. For companies not in the Russell 3000 universe, the company must not have underperformed both its peers and index on the basis of both one-year and three-year total shareholder returns, unless there has been a change in the Chairman/CEO position within that time;

 

   

The company does not have any problematic governance or management issues, examples of which include, but are not limited to:

 

  Egregious compensation practices;

 

  Multiple related-party transactions or other issues putting director independence at risk;

 

  Corporate and/or management scandals;

 

  Excessive problematic corporate governance provisions; or

 

  Flagrant actions by management or the board with potential or realized negative impacts on shareholders.

Majority of Independent Directors/Establishment of Independent Committees

Vote FOR shareholder proposals asking that a majority or more of directors be independent unless the board composition already meets the proposed threshold by RMG’s definition of independent outsider. (See Categorization of Directors.)

Vote FOR shareholder proposals asking that board audit, compensation, and/or nominating committees be composed exclusively of independent directors if they currently do not meet that standard.

Majority Vote Shareholder Proposals

Generally vote FOR precatory and binding resolutions requesting that the board change the company ‘s bylaws to stipulate that directors need to be elected with an affirmative majority of votes cast, provided it does not conflict with the state law where the company is incorporated. Binding resolutions need to allow for a carve-out for a plurality vote standard when there are more nominees than board seats.

Companies are strongly encouraged to also adopt a post-election policy (also know as a director resignation policy) that will provide guidelines so that the company will promptly address the situation of a holdover director.

Open Access (Proxy Access)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking for open or proxy access, taking into account:

 

   

The ownership threshold proposed in the resolution;

 

   

The proponent’s rationale for the proposal at the targeted company in terms of board and director conduct.

 

B-44


Table of Contents

Proxy Contests- Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the election of directors in contested elections, considering the following factors:

 

   

Long-term financial performance of the target company relative to its industry;

 

   

Management’s track record;

 

   

Background to the proxy contest;

 

   

Qualifications of director nominees (both slates);

 

   

Strategic plan of dissident slate and quality of critique against management;

 

   

Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates);

 

   

Stock ownership positions.

Require More Nominees than Open Seats

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that would require a company to nominate more candidates than the number of open board seats.

Term Limits

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors through term limits. However, scrutinize boards where the average tenure of all directors exceeds 15 years for independence from management and for sufficient turnover to ensure that new perspectives are being added to the board.

Vote No Campaigns

In cases where companies are targeted in connection with public “vote no” campaigns, evaluate director nominees under the existing governance policies for voting on director nominees in uncontested elections. Take into consideration the arguments submitted by shareholders and other publicly-available information.

3. Shareholder Rights  & Defenses

Advance Notice Requirements for Shareholder Proposals/Nominations

Vote CASE-BY-CASE basis on advance notice proposals, giving support to those proposals which allow shareholders to submit proposals/nominations as close to the meeting date as reasonably possible and within the broadest window possible, recognizing the need to allow sufficient notice for company, regulatory and shareholder review.

To be reasonable, the company’s deadline for shareholder notice of a proposal/nominations must not be more than 60 days prior to the meeting, with a submittal window of at least 30 days prior to the deadline. The submittal window is the period under which a shareholder must file his proposal/nominations prior to the deadline.

 

B-45


Table of Contents

 

In general, support additional efforts by companies to ensure full disclosure in regard to a proponent’s economic and voting position in the company so long as the informational requirements are reasonable and aimed at providing shareholders with the necessary information to review such proposals.

Amend Bylaws without Shareholder Consent

Vote AGAINST proposals giving the board exclusive authority to amend the bylaws.

Vote FOR proposals giving the board the ability to amend the bylaws in addition to shareholders.

Confidential Voting

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that corporations adopt confidential voting, use independent vote tabulators, and use independent inspectors of election, as long as the proposal includes a provision for proxy contests as follows: In the case of a contested election, management should be permitted to request that the dissident group honor its confidential voting policy. If the dissidents agree, the policy remains in place. If the dissidents will not agree, the confidential voting policy is waived.

Vote FOR management proposals to adopt confidential voting.

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

Control share acquisition statutes function by denying shares their voting rights when they contribute to ownership in excess of certain thresholds. Voting rights for those shares exceeding ownership limits may only be restored by approval of either a majority or supermajority of disinterested shares. Thus, control share acquisition statutes effectively require a hostile bidder to put its offer to a shareholder vote or risk voting disenfranchisement if the bidder continues buying up a large block of shares.

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share acquisition statutes unless doing so would enable the completion of a takeover that would be detrimental to shareholders.

Vote AGAINST proposals to amend the charter to include control share acquisition provisions.

Vote FOR proposals to restore voting rights to the control shares.

Control Share Cash-Out Provisions

Control share cash-out statutes give dissident shareholders the right to “cash-out” of their position in a company at the expense of the shareholder who has taken a control position. In other words, when an investor crosses a preset threshold level, remaining shareholders are given the right to sell their shares to the acquirer, who must buy them at the highest acquiring price.

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share cash-out statutes.

 

B-46


Table of Contents

 

Disgorgement Provisions

Disgorgement provisions require an acquirer or potential acquirer of more than a certain percentage of a company’s stock to disgorge, or pay back, to the company any profits realized from the sale of that company’s stock purchased 24 months before achieving control status. All sales of company stock by the acquirer occurring within a certain period of time (between 18 months and 24 months) prior to the investor’s gaining control status are subject to these recapture-of-profits provisions.

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of state disgorgement provisions.

Fair Price Provisions

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to adopt fair price provisions (provisions that stipulate that an acquirer must pay the same price to acquire all shares as it paid to acquire the control shares), evaluating factors such as the vote required to approve the proposed acquisition, the vote required to repeal the fair price provision, and the mechanism for determining the fair price.

Generally, vote AGAINST fair price provisions with shareholder vote requirements greater than a majority of disinterested shares.

Freeze-Out Provisions

Vote FOR proposals to opt out of state freeze-out provisions. Freeze-out provisions force an investor who surpasses a certain ownership threshold in a company to wait a specified period of time before gaining control of the company.

Greenmail

Greenmail payments are targeted share repurchases by management of company stock from individuals or groups seeking control of the company. Since only the hostile party receives payment, usually at a substantial premium over the market value of its shares, the practice discriminates against all other shareholders.

Vote FOR proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on anti-greenmail proposals when they are bundled with other charter or bylaw amendments.

Net Operating Loss (NOL) Protective Amendments

For management proposals to adopt a protective amendment for the stated purpose of protecting a company’s net operating losses (“NOLs”), the following factors should be considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

The ownership threshold (NOL protective amendments generally prohibit stock ownership transfers that would result in a new 5-percent holder or increase the stock ownership percentage of an existing five-percent holder);

 

   

The value of the NOLs;

 

B-47


Table of Contents

 

   

Shareholder protection mechanisms (sunset provision or commitment to cause expiration of the protective amendment upon exhaustion or expiration of the NOL);

 

   

The company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, track record of responsiveness to shareholders, and any other problematic governance concerns; and

 

   

Any other factors that may be applicable.

Poison Pills- Shareholder Proposals to put Pill to a Vote and/or Adopt a Pill Policy

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that the company submit its poison pill to a shareholder vote or redeem it UNLESS the company has: (1) A shareholder approved poison pill in place; or (2) The company has adopted a policy concerning the adoption of a pill in the future specifying that the board will only adopt a shareholder rights plan if either:

 

   

Shareholders have approved the adoption of the plan; or

 

   

The board, in its exercise of its fiduciary responsibilities, determines that it is in the best interest of shareholders under the circumstances to adopt a pill without the delay in adoption that would result from seeking stockholder approval (i.e., the “fiduciary out” provision). A poison pill adopted under this fiduciary out will be put to a shareholder ratification vote within 12 months of adoption or expire. If the pill is not approved by a majority of the votes cast on this issue, the plan will immediately terminate.

If the shareholder proposal calls for a time period of less than 12 months for shareholder ratification after adoption, vote FOR the proposal, but add the caveat that a vote within 12 months would be considered sufficient implementation.

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to Ratify Poison Pill

Vote CASE-by-CASE on management proposals on poison pill ratification, focusing on the features of the shareholder rights plan. Rights plans should contain the following attributes:

 

   

No lower than a 20% trigger, flip-in or flip-over;

 

   

A term of no more than three years;

 

   

No dead-hand, slow-hand, no-hand or similar feature that limits the ability of a future board to redeem the pill;

 

   

Shareholder redemption feature (qualifying offer clause); if the board refuses to redeem the pill 90 days after a qualifying offer is announced, 10 percent of the shares may call a special meeting or seek a written consent to vote on rescinding the pill.

In addition, the rationale for adopting the pill should be thoroughly explained by the company. In examining the request for the pill, take into consideration the company’s existing governance structure, including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, and any problematic governance concerns.

 

B-48


Table of Contents

 

Poison Pills- Management Proposals to ratify a Pill to preserve Net Operating Losses (NOLs)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on management proposals for poison pill ratification. For management proposals to adopt a poison pill for the stated purpose of preserving a company’s net operating losses (“NOLs”), the following factors are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

The ownership threshold to transfer (NOL pills generally have a trigger slightly below 5%);

 

   

The value of the NOLs;

 

   

The term;

 

   

Shareholder protection mechanisms (sunset provision, or commitment to cause expiration of the pill upon exhaustion or expiration of NOLs);

 

   

The company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, track record of responsiveness to shareholders, and any other problematic governance concerns; and

 

   

Any other factors that may be applicable.

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses. When voting in conjunction with support of a dissident slate, vote FOR the reimbursement of all appropriate proxy solicitation expenses associated with the election.

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for the reimbursement of reasonable costs incurred in connection with nominating one or more candidates in a contested election where the following apply:

 

   

The election of fewer than 50% of the directors to be elected is contested in the election;

 

   

One or more of the dissident’s candidates is elected;

 

   

Shareholders are not permitted to cumulate their votes for directors; and

 

   

The election occurred, and the expenses were incurred, after the adoption of this bylaw.

Reincorporation Proposals

Management or shareholder proposals to change a company’s state of incorporation should be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, giving consideration to both financial and corporate governance concerns including the following:

 

   

Reasons for reincorporation;

 

   

Comparison of company’s governance practices and provisions prior to and following the reincorporation; and

 

   

Comparison of corporation laws of original state and destination state

Vote FOR reincorporation when the economic factors outweigh any neutral or negative governance changes.

 

B-49


Table of Contents

 

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

Vote AGAINST management and shareholder proposals to restrict of prohibit shareholders’ to act by written consent.

Generally vote FOR management and shareholder proposals that provide shareholders with the ability to act by written consent taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Shareholders’ current right to act by written consent;

 

   

Consent threshold;

 

   

The inclusion of exclusionary or prohibitive language;

 

   

Investor ownership structure; and

 

   

Shareholder support of and management’s response to previous shareholder proposals.

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

Vote AGAINST management or shareholder proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholders’ ability to call special meetings.

Generally vote FOR management or shareholder proposals that provide shareholders with the ability to call special meetings taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Shareholders’ current right to call special meetings;

 

   

Minimum ownership threshold necessary to call special meetings (10% preferred);

 

   

The inclusion of exclusionary or prohibitive language;

 

   

Investor ownership structure; and

 

   

Shareholder support of and management’s response to previous shareholder proposals.

Stakeholder Provisions

Vote AGAINST proposals that ask the board to consider non-shareholder constituencies or other non-financial effects when evaluating a merger or business combination.

State Antitakeover Statutes

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to opt in or out of state takeover statutes (including control share acquisition statutes, control share cash-out statutes, freeze-out provisions, fair price provisions, stakeholder laws, poison pill endorsements, severance pay and labor contract provisions, anti-greenmail provisions, and disgorgement provisions).

 

B-50


Table of Contents

 

Supermajority Vote Requirements

Vote AGAINST proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote.

Vote FOR management or shareholder proposals to reduce supermajority vote requirements. However, for companies with shareholder(s) who have significant ownership levels, vote CASE-BY-CASE, taking into account:

 

   

Ownership structure;

 

   

Quorum requirements; and

 

   

Supermajority vote requirements.

4. CAPITAL/RESTRUCTURING

Capital

Adjustments to Par Value of Common Stock

Vote FOR management proposals to reduce the par value of common stock.

Common Stock Authorization

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to increase the number of shares of common stock authorized for issuance. Take into account company-specific factors which include, at a minimum, the following:

 

   

Past Board Performance:

 

   

The company’s use of authorized shares during the last three years;

 

   

One- and three-year total shareholder return; and

 

   

The board’s governance structure and practices;

 

   

The Current Request:

 

   

Disclosure in the proxy statement of the specific reasons for the proposed increase;

 

   

The dilutive impact of the request as determined through an allowable cap generated by

 

   

RiskMetrics’ quantitative model, which examines the company’s need for shares and its three-year total shareholder return; and

 

   

Risks to shareholders of not approving the request.

Vote AGAINST proposals at companies with more than one class of common stock to increase the number of authorized shares of the class that has superior voting rights.

Issue Stock for Use with Rights Plan

Vote AGAINST proposals that increase authorized common stock for the explicit purpose of implementing a non-shareholder approved shareholder rights plan (poison pill).

 

B-51


Table of Contents

 

Preemptive Rights

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals that seek preemptive rights, taking into consideration: the size of a company, the characteristics of its shareholder base, and the liquidity of the stock.

Preferred Stock

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to increase the number of shares of preferred stock authorized for issuance. Take into account company-specific factors that include, at a minimum, the following:

 

   

Past Board Performance:

 

   

The company’s use of authorized preferred shares during the last three years;

 

   

One- and three-year total shareholder return; and

 

   

The board’s governance structure and practices;

 

   

The Current Request:

 

   

Disclosure in the proxy statement of specific reasons for the proposed increase;

 

   

In cases where the company has existing authorized preferred stock, the dilutive impact of the request as determined through an allowable cap generated by RiskMetrics’ quantitative model, which examines the company’s need for shares and three-year total shareholder return;

 

   

Whether the shares requested are blank check preferred shares, and whether they are declawed.

Vote AGAINST proposals at companies with more than one class or series of preferred stock to increase the number of authorized shares of the class or series that has superior voting rights.

Recapitalization

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on recapitalizations (reclassifications of securities), taking into account the following:

 

   

More simplified capital structure;

 

   

Enhanced liquidity;

 

   

Fairness of conversion terms;

 

   

Impact on voting power and dividends;

 

   

Reasons for the reclassification;

 

   

Conflicts of interest; and

 

   

Other alternatives considered.

Reverse Stock Splits

Vote FOR management proposals to implement a reverse stock split when the number of authorized shares will be proportionately reduced.

Vote FOR management proposals to implement a reverse stock split to avoid delisting.

 

B-52


Table of Contents

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to implement a reverse stock split that do not proportionately reduce the number of shares authorized for issue based on the allowable increased calculated using the Capital Structure model.

Share Repurchase Programs

Vote FOR management proposals to institute open-market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

Stock Distributions: Splits and Dividends

Vote FOR management proposals to increase the common share authorization for a stock split or share dividend, provided that the increase in authorized shares would not result in an excessive number of shares available for issuance as determined using a model developed by RMG.

Tracking Stock

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the creation of tracking stock, weighing the strategic value of the transaction against such factors as:

 

   

Adverse governance changes;

 

   

Excessive increases in authorized capital stock;

 

   

Unfair method of distribution;

 

   

Diminution of voting rights;

 

   

Adverse conversion features;

 

   

Negative impact on stock option plans; and

 

   

Alternatives such as spin-off.

Restructuring

Appraisal Rights

Vote FOR proposals to restore, or provide shareholders with rights of appraisal.

Asset Purchases

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on asset purchase proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Purchase price;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

Financial and strategic benefits;

 

B-53


Table of Contents

 

   

How the deal was negotiated;

 

   

Conflicts of interest; Other alternatives for the business;

 

   

Non-completion risk.

Asset Sales

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on asset sales, considering the following factors:

 

   

Impact on the balance sheet/working capital;

 

   

Potential elimination of diseconomies;

 

   

Anticipated financial and operating benefits;

 

   

Anticipated use of funds;

 

   

Value received for the asset;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

How the deal was negotiated;

 

   

Conflicts of interest.

Bundled Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on bundled or “conditional” proxy proposals. In the case of items that are conditioned upon each other, examine the benefits and costs of the packaged items. In instances when the joint effect of the conditioned items is not in shareholders’ best interests, vote AGAINST the proposals. In the combined effect is positive, support such proposals.

Conversion of Securities

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding conversion of securities. When evaluating these proposals the investor should review the dilution to existing shareholders, the conversion price relative to market value, financial issues, control issues, termination penalties, and conflicts of interest.

Vote FOR the conversion if it is expected that the company will be subject to onerous penalties or will be forced to file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

Corporate Reorganization/Debt Restructuring/Prepackaged Bankruptcy Plans/Reverse Leveraged Buyouts/Wrap Plans

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to increase common and/or preferred shares and to issue shares as part of a debt restructuring plan, taking into consideration the following:

 

   

Dilution to existing shareholders’ position;

 

   

Terms of the offer;

 

   

Financial issues;

 

B-54


Table of Contents

 

   

Management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives;

 

   

Control issues;

 

   

Conflicts of interest.

Vote FOR the debt restructuring if it is expected that the company will file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

Formation of Holding Company

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding the formation of a holding company, taking into consideration the following:

 

   

The reasons for the change;

 

   

Any financial or tax benefits;

 

   

Regulatory benefits;

 

   

Increases in capital structure;

 

   

Changes to the articles of incorporation or bylaws of the company.

Absent compelling financial reasons to recommend the transaction, vote AGAINST the formation of a holding company if the transaction would include either of the following:

 

   

Increases in common or preferred stock in excess of the allowable maximum (see discussion under “Capital Structure”);

 

   

Adverse changes in shareholder rights.

Going Private and Going Dark Transactions (LBOs and Minority Squeeze-outs)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on going private transactions, taking into account the following:

 

   

Offer price/premium;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

How the deal was negotiated;

 

   

Conflicts of interest;

 

   

Other alternatives/offers considered; and

 

   

Non-completion risk.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on “going dark” transactions, determining whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by taking into consideration:

 

   

Whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly-traded (examination of trading volume, liquidity, and market research of the stock);

 

   

Balanced interests of continuing vs. cashed-out shareholders, taking into account the following:

 

  Are all shareholders able to participate in the transaction?

 

  Will there be a liquid market for remaining shareholders following the transaction?

 

B-55


Table of Contents

 

  Does the company have strong corporate governance?

 

  Will insiders reap the gains of control following the proposed transaction?

 

  Does the state of incorporation have laws requiring continued reporting that may benefit shareholders?

Joint Ventures

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to form joint ventures, taking into account the following:

 

   

Percentage of assets/business contributed;

 

   

Percentage ownership;

 

   

Financial and strategic benefits;

 

   

Governance structure;

 

   

Conflicts of interest;

 

   

Other alternatives;

 

   

Noncompletion risk.

Liquidations

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on liquidations, taking into account the following:

 

   

Management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives;

 

   

Appraisal value of assets; and

 

   

The compensation plan for executives managing the liquidation.

Vote FOR the liquidation if the company will file for bankruptcy if the proposal is not approved.

Mergers and Acquisitions

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on mergers and acquisitions. Review and evaluate the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors including:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, emphasis is placed on the offer premium, market reaction and strategic rationale.

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction should cause closer scrutiny of a deal.

 

   

Strategic rationale — Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions.

 

   

Negotiations and process — Were the terms of the transaction negotiated at arm’s-length? Was the process fair and equitable? A fair process helps to ensure the best price for shareholders. Significant

 

B-56


Table of Contents
 

negotiation “wins” can also signify the deal makers’ competency. The comprehensiveness of the sales process (e.g., full auction, partial auction, no auction) can also affect shareholder value.

 

   

Conflicts of interest — Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? As the result of potential conflicts, the directors and officers of the company may be more likely to vote to approve a merger than if they did not hold these interests. Consider whether these interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger. The CIC figure presented in the “RMG Transaction Summary” section of this report is an aggregate figure that can in certain cases be a misleading indicator of the true value transfer from shareholders to insiders. Where such figure appears to be excessive, analyze the underlying assumptions to determine whether a potential conflict exists.

 

   

Governance — Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance.

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

Vote CASE-BY-CASE basis on proposals to common shareholders on bankruptcy plans of reorganization, considering the following factors including, but not limited to:

 

   

Estimated value and financial prospects of the reorganized company;

 

   

Percentage ownership of current shareholders in the reorganized company;

 

   

Whether shareholders are adequately represented in the reorganization process (particularly through the existence of an Official Equity Committee);

 

   

The cause(s) of the bankruptcy filing, and the extent to which the plan of reorganization addresses the cause(s);

 

   

Existence of a superior alternative to the plan of reorganization; and

 

   

Governance of the reorganized company.

Private Placements/Warrants/Convertible Debentures

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding private placements taking into consideration:

 

  1. Dilution to existing shareholders’ position.

 

  The amount and timing of shareholder ownership dilution should be weighed against the needs and proposed shareholder benefits of the capital infusion.

 

  2. Terms of the offer — discount/premium in purchase price to investor, including any fairness opinion; conversion features; termination penalties; exit strategy.

 

  The terms of the offer should be weighed against the alternatives of the company and in light of company’s financial issues.

 

  When evaluating the magnitude of a private placement discount or premium, RiskMetrics will consider whether it is affected by liquidity, due diligence, control and monitoring issues, capital scarcity, information asymmetry and anticipation of future performance.

 

B-57


Table of Contents

 

  3. Financial issues include but are not limited to examining the following:

 

  Company’s financial situation;

 

  Degree of need for capital;

 

  Use of proceeds;

 

  Effect of the financing on the company’s cost of capital;

 

  Current and proposed cash burn rate; and

 

  Going concern viability and the state of the capital and credit markets.

 

  4. Management’s efforts to pursue alternatives and whether the company engaged in a process to evaluate alternatives. A fair, unconstrained process helps to ensure the best price for shareholders. Financing alternatives can include joint ventures, partnership, merger or sale of part or all of the company.

 

  5. Control issues:

 

  Change in management;

 

  Change in control,

 

  Guaranteed board and committee seats;

 

  Standstill provisions;

 

  Voting agreements;

 

  Veto power over certain corporate actions.

Minority versus majority ownership and corresponding minority discount or majority control premium

 

  6. Conflicts of interest

 

  Conflicts of interest should be viewed from the perspective of the company and the investor.

 

  Were the terms of the transaction negotiated at arm’s-length? Are managerial incentives aligned with shareholder interests?

 

  7. Market reaction

 

  The market’s response to the proposed deal. A negative market reaction is a cause for concern. Market reaction may be addressed by analyzing the one day impact on the unaffected stock price.

Vote FOR the private placement if it is expected that the company will file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

Special Purpose Acquisition Corporations (SPACs)

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on SPAC mergers and acquisitions taking into account the following:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value being paid by the SPAC reasonable? SPACs generally lack an independent fairness opinion and the financials on the target may be limited. Compare the conversion price with the intrinsic value of the target company provided in the fairness opinion. Also, evaluate the proportionate value of the combined entity attributable to the SPAC IPO shareholders versus the pre-merger value of SPAC. Additionally, a private company discount may be applied to the target, if it is a private entity.

 

B-58


Table of Contents

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction may be a cause for concern. Market reaction may be addressed by analyzing the one-day impact on the unaffected stock price.

 

   

Deal timing — A main driver for most transactions is that the SPAC charter typically requires the deal to be complete within 18 to 24 months, or the SPAC is to be liquidated. Evaluate the valuation, market reaction, and potential conflicts of interest for deals that are announced close to the liquidation date.

 

   

Negotiations and process — What was the process undertaken to identify potential target companies within specified industry or location specified in charter? Consider the background of the sponsors.

 

   

Conflicts of interest — How are sponsors benefiting from the transaction compared to IPO shareholders? Potential conflicts could arise if a fairness opinion is issued by the insiders to qualify the deal rather than a third party or if management is encouraged to pay a higher price for the target because of an 80% rule (the charter requires that the fair market value of the target is at least equal to 80% of net assets of the SPAC). Also, there may be sense of urgency by the management team of the SPAC to close the deal since its charter typically requires a transaction to be completed within the 18-24 month timeframe.

 

   

Voting agreements — Are the sponsors entering into enter into any voting agreements/ tender offers with shareholders who are likely to vote AGAINST the proposed merger or exercise conversion rights?

 

   

Governance — What is the impact of having the SPAC CEO or founder on key committees following the proposed merger?

Spinoffs

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on spin-offs, considering:

 

   

Tax and regulatory advantages;

 

   

Planned use of the sale proceeds;

 

   

Valuation of spinoff;

 

   

Fairness opinion;

 

   

Benefits to the parent company;

 

   

Conflicts of interest;

 

   

Managerial incentives;

 

   

Corporate governance changes;

 

   

Changes in the capital structure.

Value Maximization Shareholder Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals seeking to maximize shareholder value by hiring a financial advisor to explore strategic alternatives, selling the company or liquidating the company and distributing the proceeds to shareholders. These proposals should be evaluated based on the following factors:

 

   

Prolonged poor performance with no turnaround in sight;

 

   

Signs of entrenched board and management;

 

   

Strategic plan in place for improving value;

 

B-59


Table of Contents

 

   

Likelihood of receiving reasonable value in a sale or dissolution; and

 

   

Whether company is actively exploring its strategic options, including retaining a financial advisor.

5. COMPENSATION

Executive Pay Evaluation

Underlying all evaluations are five global principles that most investors expect corporations to adhere to in designing and administering executive and director compensation programs:

 

  1. Maintain appropriate pay-for-performance alignment, with emphasis on long-term shareholder value: This principle encompasses overall executive pay practices, which must be designed to attract, retain, and appropriately motivate the key employees who drive shareholder value creation over the long term. It will take into consideration, among other factors, the link between pay and performance; the mix between fixed and variable pay; performance goals; and equity-based plan costs;

 

  2. Avoid arrangements that risk “pay for failure”: This principle addresses the appropriateness of long or indefinite contracts, excessive severance packages, and guaranteed compensation;

 

  3. Maintain an independent and effective compensation committee: This principle promotes oversight of executive pay programs by directors with appropriate skills, knowledge, experience, and a sound process for compensation decision-making (e.g., including access to independent expertise and advice when needed);

 

  4. Provide shareholders with clear, comprehensive compensation disclosures: This principle underscores the importance of informative and timely disclosures that enable shareholders to evaluate executive pay practices fully and fairly;

 

  5. Avoid inappropriate pay to non-executive directors: This principle recognizes the interests of shareholders in ensuring that compensation to outside directors does not compromise their independence and ability to make appropriate judgments in overseeing managers’ pay and performance. At the market level, it may incorporate a variety of generally accepted best practices.

Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation- Management Proposals (Management Say-on-Pay)

Evaluate executive pay and practices, as well as certain aspects of outside director compensation, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST management say on pay (MSOP) proposals, AGAINST/WITHHOLD on compensation committee members (or, in rare cases where the full board is deemed responsible, all directors including the CEO), and/or AGAINST an equity-based incentive plan proposal if:

 

   

There is a misalignment between CEO pay and company performance (pay for performance);

 

   

The company maintains problematic pay practices;

 

   

The board exhibits poor communication and responsiveness to shareholders.

Voting Alternatives

In general, the management say on pay (MSOP) ballot item is the primary focus of voting on executive pay practices — dissatisfaction with compensation practices can be expressed by voting against MSOP rather than

 

B-60


Table of Contents

withholding or voting against the compensation committee. However, if there is no MSOP on the ballot, then the negative vote will apply to members of the compensation committee. In addition, in egregious cases, or if the board fails to respond to concerns raised by a prior MSOP proposal, then vote withhold or against compensation committee members (or, if the full board is deemed accountable, all directors). If the negative factors involve equity-based compensation, then vote AGAINST an equity-based plan proposal presented for shareholder approval.

Additional CASE-BY-CASE considerations for the management say on pay (MSOP) proposals:

 

   

Evaluation of performance metrics in short-term and long-term plans, as discussed and explained in the Compensation Discussion & Analysis (CD&A). Consider the measures, goals, and target awards reported by the company for executives’ short- and long-term incentive awards: disclosure, explanation of their alignment with the company’s business strategy, and whether goals appear to be sufficiently challenging in relation to resulting payouts;

 

   

Evaluation of peer group benchmarking used to set target pay or award opportunities. Consider the rationale stated by the company for constituents in its pay benchmarking peer group, as well as the benchmark targets it uses to set or validate executives’ pay ( e.g., median, 75th percentile, etc.,) to ascertain whether the benchmarking process is sound or may result in pay “ratcheting” due to inappropriate peer group constituents (e.g., much larger companies) or targeting (e.g., above median); and

 

   

Balance of performance-based versus non-performance-based pay. Consider the ratio of performance-based (not including plain vanilla stock options) vs. non-performance-based pay elements reported for the CEO’s latest reported fiscal year compensation, especially in conjuction with concerns about other factors such as performance metrics/goals, benchmarking practices, and pay-for-performance disconnects.

Primary Evaluation Factors for Executive Pay

Pay for Performance

Evaluate the alignment of the CEO’s pay with performance over time, focusing particularly on companies that have underperformed their peers over a sustained period. From a shareholders’ perspective, performance is predominantly gauged by the company’s stock performance over time. Even when financial or operational measures are utilized in incentive awards, the achievement related to these measures should ultimately translate into superior shareholder returns in the long-term.

Focus on companies with sustained underperformance relative to peers, considering the following key factors:

 

   

Whether a company’s one-year and three-year total shareholder returns (“TSR”) are in the bottom half of its industry group (i.e., four-digit GICS – Global Industry Classification Group); and

 

   

Whether the total compensation of a CEO who has served at least two consecutive fiscal years is aligned with the company’s total shareholder return over time, including both recent and long-term periods.

If a company falls in the bottom half of its four-digit GICS, further analysis of the CD&A is required to better understand the various pay elements and whether they create or reinforce shareholder alignment. Also assess the CEO’s pay relative to the company’s TSR over a time horizon of at least five years. The most recent year-over-year increase or decrease in pay remains a key consideration, but there will be additional emphasis on the long term trend of CEO total compensation relative to shareholder return. Also consider the mix of performance-based compensation relative to total compensation. In general, standard stock options or time-vested restricted stock are not considered to be performance-based. If a company provides performance-based

 

B-61


Table of Contents

incentives to its executives, the company is highly encouraged to provide the complete disclosure of the performance measure and goals (hurdle rate) so that shareholders can assess the rigor of the performance program. The use of non-GAAP financial metrics also makes it very challenging for shareholders to ascertain the rigor of the program as shareholders often cannot tell the type of adjustments being made and if the adjustments were made consistently. Complete and transparent disclosure helps shareholders to better understand the company’s pay for performance linkage.

Problematic Pay Practices

The focus is on executive compensation practices that contravene the global pay principles, including:

 

   

Problematic practices related to non-performance-based compensation elements;

 

   

Incentives that may motivate excessive risk-taking; and

 

   

Options Backdating.

Non-Performance based Compensation Elements

Companies adopt a variety of pay arrangements that may be acceptable in their particular industries, or unique for a particular situation, and all companies are reviewed on a case-by-case basis. However, there are certain adverse practices that are particularly contrary to a performance-based pay philosophy, including guaranteed pay and excessive or inappropriate non-performance-based pay elements.

While not exhaustive, this is the list of practices that carry greatest weight in this consideration and may result in negative vote recommendations on a stand-alone basis. For more details, please refer to RMG’s Compensation FAQ document: http://www.riskmetrics.com/policy/2010_compensation_FAQ:

 

   

Multi-year guarantees for salary increases, non-performance based bonuses, and equity compensation;

 

   

Including additional years of unworked service that result in significant additional benefits, without sufficient justification, or including long-term equity awards in the pension calculation;

 

   

Perquisites for former and/or retired executives, and extraordinary relocation benefits (including home buyouts) for current executives;

 

   

Change-in-control payments exceeding 3 times base salary and target bonus; change-in-control payments without job loss or substantial diminution of duties (“Single Triggers”); new or materially amended agreements that provide for “modified single triggers” (under which an executive may voluntarily leave for any reason and still receive the change-in-control severance package); new or materially amended agreements that provide for an excise tax gross-up (including “modified gross-ups”) ;

 

   

Tax Reimbursements related to executive perquisites or other payments such as personal use of corporate aircraft, executive life insurance, bonus, etc; (see also excise tax gross-ups above)

 

   

Dividends or dividend equivalents paid on unvested performance shares or units;

 

   

Executives using company stock in hedging activities, such as “cashless” collars, forward sales, equity swaps or other similar arrangements; or

 

   

Repricing or replacing of underwater stock options/stock appreciation rights without prior shareholder approval (including cash buyouts and voluntary surrender/subsequent regrant of underwater options).

Incentives that may Motivate Excessive Risk-Taking

Assess company policies and disclosure related to compensation that could incentivize excessive risk-taking, for example:

 

   

Guaranteed bonuses;

 

B-62


Table of Contents

 

   

A single performance metric used for short- and long-term plans;

 

   

Lucrative severance packages;

 

   

High pay opportunities relative to industry peers;

 

   

Disproportionate supplemental pensions; or

 

   

Mega annual equity grants that provide unlimited upside with no downside risk.

Factors that potentially mitigate the impact of risky incentives include rigorous claw-back provisions and robust stock ownership/holding guidelines.

Options Backdating

Vote CASE-by-CASE on options backdating issues. Generally, when a company has recently practiced options backdating, WITHHOLD from or vote AGAINST the compensation committee, depending on the severity of the practices and the subsequent corrective actions on the part of the board. When deciding on votes on compensation committee members who oversaw questionable options grant practices or current compensation committee members who fail to respond to the issue proactively, consider several factors, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Reason and motive for the options backdating issue, such as inadvertent vs. deliberate grant date changes;

 

   

Duration of options backdating;

 

   

Size of restatement due to options backdating;

 

   

Corrective actions taken by the board or compensation committee, such as canceling or re-pricing backdated options, the recouping of option gains on backdated grants; and

 

   

Adoption of a grant policy that prohibits backdating, and creates a fixed grant schedule or window period for equity grants in the future.

A CASE-by-CASE analysis approach allows distinctions to be made between companies that had “sloppy” plan administration versus those that acted deliberately and/or committed fraud, as well as those companies that subsequently took corrective action. Cases where companies have committed fraud are considered most egregious.

Board Communications and Responsiveness

Consider the following factors on a CASE-BY-CASE basis when evaluating ballot items related to executive pay:

 

   

Poor disclosure practices, including:

 

  Unclear explanation of how the CEO is involved in the pay setting process;

 

  Retrospective performance targets and methodology not discussed;

 

  Methodology for benchmarking practices and/or peer group not disclosed and explained.

 

   

Board’s responsiveness to investor input and engagement on compensation issues, for example:

 

  Failure to respond to majority-supported shareholder proposals on executive pay topics; or

 

  Failure to respond to concerns raised in connection with significant opposition to MSOP proposals.

 

B-63


Table of Contents

 

Equity-Based and Other Incentive Plans

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on equity-based compensation plans. Vote AGAINST the equity plan if any of the following factors apply:

 

   

The total cost of the company’s equity plans is unreasonable;

 

   

The plan expressly permits the repricing of stock options/stock appreciate rights (SARs) without prior shareholder approval;

 

   

The CEO is a participant in the proposed equity-based compensation plan and there is a disconnect between CEO pay and the company’s performance where over 50 percent of the year-over-year increase is attributed to equity awards (see Pay-for-Performance);

 

   

The company’s three year burn rate exceeds the greater of 2% or the mean plus one standard deviation of its industry group;

 

   

Liberal Change of Control Definition: The plan provides for the acceleration of vesting of equity awards even though an actual change in control may not occur (e.g., upon shareholder approval of a transaction or the announcement of a tender offer); or

 

   

The plan is a vehicle for problematic pay practices.

Each of these factors is described below:

Cost of Equity Plans

Generally, vote AGAINST equity plans if the cost is unreasonable. For non-employee director plans, vote FOR the plan if certain factors are met (see Director Compensation section).

The cost of the equity plans is expressed as Shareholder Value Transfer (SVT), which is measured using a binomial option pricing model that assesses the amount of shareholders’ equity flowing out of the company to employees and directors. SVT is expressed as both a dollar amount and as a percentage of market value, and includes the new shares proposed, shares available under existing plans, and shares granted but unexercised. All award types are valued. For omnibus plans, unless limitations are placed on the most expensive types of awards (for example, full value awards), the assumption is made that all awards to be granted will be the most expensive types. See discussion of specific types of awards.

The Shareholder Value Transfer is reasonable if it falls below the company-specific allowable cap. The allowable cap is determined as follows: The top quartile performers in each industry group (using the Global Industry Classification Standard: GICS) are identified. Benchmark SVT levels for each industry are established based on these top performers’ historic SVT. Regression analyses are run on each industry group to identify the variables most strongly correlated to SVT. The benchmark industry SVT level is then adjusted upwards or downwards for the specific company by plugging the company-specific performance measures, size and cash compensation into the industry cap equations to arrive at the company’s allowable cap.

Repricing Provisions

Vote AGAINST plans that expressly permit the repricing or exchange of underwater stock options without prior shareholder approval, even if the cost of the plan is reasonable. Also, vote AGAINST OR WITHHOLD from members of the Compensation Committee who approved and/or implemented a repricing or an option exchange program, by buying out underwater options for stock, cash or other consideration or canceling underwater options and regranting options with a lower exercise price, without prior shareholder approval, even if such repricings are allowed in their equity plan.

Vote AGAINST plans if the company has a history of repricing options without shareholder approval, and the applicable listing standards would not preclude them from doing so.

 

B-64


Table of Contents

 

Three-Year Burn Rate/Burn Rate Commitment

Generally vote AGAINST equity plans for companies whose average three-year burn rates exceeds the greater of: (1) the mean plus one standard deviation of the company’s GICS group segmented by Russell 3000 index and non-Russell 3000 index (per the following Burn Rate Table); or (2) two percent of weighted common shares outstanding. The three-year burn rate policy does not apply to non-employee director plans unless outside directors receive a significant portion of shares each year.

The annual burn rate is calculated as follows:

Annual Burn rate = (# of options granted + # of full value shares awarded * Multiplier) / Weighted Average common shares outstanding)

However, vote FOR equity plans if the company fails this burn rate test but the company commits in a public filing to a three-year average burn rate equal to its GICS group burn rate mean plus one standard deviation (or 2%, whichever is greater), assuming all other conditions for voting FOR the plan have been met.

If a company fails to fulfill its burn rate commitment, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from the compensation committee.

For the Dec. 1, 2009 and future quarterly data downloads, RMG will use the 200-day volatility for the shareholder value transfer and burn rate policies. We will also use the 200-day average stock price for the shareholder value transfer policy.

Burn Rate Table for 2010

 

          Russell 3000     Non-Russell 3000  

GICS

  

Description

   Mean     Standard
Deviation
    Mean+
STDEV
    Mean     Standard
Deviation
    Mean+
STDEV
 

1010

   Energy      1.07     1.08     2.14     2.04     2.26     4.30

1510

   Materials      0.94     0.68     1.63     1.97     2.57     4.54

2010

   Capital Goods      1.10     0.85     1.95     2.07     2.62     4.69

2020

   Commercial Services & Supplies      1.67     1.23     2.89     1.82     1.71     3.53

2030

   Transportation      1.20     0.93     2.13     1.36     0.95     2.31

2510

   Automobiles & Components      1.36     1.63     2.99     1.36     1.63     2.99

2520

   Consumer Durables & Apparel      1.76     1.21     2.97     1.56     1.81     3.37

2530

   Hotels Restaurants & Leisure      1.69     1.11     2.80     1.52     1.65     3.17

2540

   Media      1.36     0.93     2.28     2.14     1.88     4.03

2550

   Retailing      1.69     1.41     3.10     2.19     1.82     4.01

3010,
3020, 3030

   Food & Staples Retailing      1.25     1.67     2.92     1.52     1.65     3.17

3510

   Health Care Equipment & Services      2.19     1.46     3.65     3.77     4.16     7.92

3520

   Pharmaceuticals & Biotechnology      3.19     1.97     5.16     4.52     4.05     8.58

4010

   Banks      1.02     1.04     2.05     0.81     1.31     2.12

4020

   Diversified Financials      2.21     2.94     5.15     4.25     4.05     8.30

4030

   Insurance      1.07     0.94     2.02     1.03     1.28     2.31

4040

   Real Estate      0.56     0.49     1.04     0.99     2.14     3.13

4510

   Software & Services      3.15     2.32     5.47     4.32     3.26     7.58

4520

   Technology Hardware & Equipment      2.60     2.18     4.79     3.32     3.76     7.08

4530

   Semiconductors & Semiconductor Equipment      2.94     1.88     4.82     4.33     2.98     7.31

5010

   Telecommunication Services      1.30     1.20     2.50     2.63     2.45     5.08

5510

   Utilities      0.41     0.39     0.80     0.76     0.88     1.64

 

B-65


Table of Contents

 

For companies that grant both full value awards and stock options to their participants, apply a premium on full value awards for the past three fiscal years. The guideline for applying the premium is as follows:

 

Stock Price Volatility

  

Multiplier

54.6% and higher

   1 full-value award will count as 1.5 option shares

36.1% or higher and less than 54.6%

   1 full-value award will count as 2.0 option shares

24.9% or higher and less than 36.1%

   1 full-value award will count as 2.5 option shares

16.5% or higher and less than 24.9%

   1 full-value award will count as 3.0 option shares

7.9% or higher and less than 16.5%

   1 full-value award will count as 3.5 option shares

Less than 7.9%

   1 full-value award will count as 4.0 option shares

Pay-for-Performance- Impact on Equity Plans

If a significant portion of the CEO’s misaligned pay is attributed to equity awards, and there is an equity plan on the ballot, vote AGAINST the equity plan, taking in to consideration:

 

   

Magnitude of pay increase/decrease in the last fiscal year;

 

   

Source of pay increase (cash or equity); and

 

   

Proportion of equity awards granted in the last fiscal year concentrated at the named executive officer level.

See Pay-for-Performance discussion under Executive Pay Evaluation for further details.

Liberal Definition of Change-in-Control

Generally vote AGAINST equity plans if the plan provides for the acceleration of vesting of equity awards even though an actual change in control may not occur. Examples of such a definition could include, but are not limited to, announcement or commencement of a tender offer, provisions for acceleration upon a “potential” takeover, shareholder approval of a merger or other transactions, or similar language.

Problematic Pay Practices

If the equity plan on the ballot is a vehicle for problematic pay practices, vote AGAINST the plan.

Specific Treatment of Certain Award Types in Equity Plan Evaluations:

Dividend Equivalent Rights

Options that have Dividend Equivalent Rights (DERs) associated with them will have a higher calculated award value than those without DERs under the binomial model, based on the value of these dividend streams. The higher value will be applied to new shares, shares available under existing plans, and shares awarded but not exercised per the plan specifications. DERS transfer more shareholder equity to employees and non-employee directors and this cost should be captured.

Liberal Share Recycling Provisions

Under net share counting provisions, shares tendered by an option holder to pay for the exercise of an option, shares withheld for taxes or shares repurchased by the company on the open market can be recycled back

 

B-66


Table of Contents

into the equity plan for awarding again. All awards with such provisions should be valued as full-value awards. Stock-settled stock appreciation rights (SSARs) will also be considered as full-value awards if a company counts only the net shares issued to employees towards their plan reserve.

Operating Partnership (OP) units in Equity Plan analysis of Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs)

For Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITS), include the common shares issuable upon conversion of outstanding Operating Partnership (OP) units in the share count for the purposes of determining: (1) market capitalization in the Shareholder Value Transfer (SVT) analysis and (2) shares outstanding in the burn rate analysis.

Option Overhang Cost

Companies with sustained positive stock performance and high overhang cost attributable to in-the-money options outstanding in excess of six years may warrant a carve-out of these options from the overhang as long as the dilution attributable to the new share request is reasonable and the company exhibits sound compensation practices. Consider, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, a carve-out of a portion of cost attributable to overhang, considering the following criteria:

 

   

Performance: Companies with sustained positive stock performance will merit greater scrutiny. Five-year total shareholder return (TSR), year-over-year performance, and peer performance could play a significant role in this determination.

 

   

Overhang Disclosure: Assess whether optionees have held in-the-money options for a prolonged period (thus reflecting their confidence in the prospects of the company). Note that this assessment would require additional disclosure regarding a company’s overhang. Specifically, the following disclosure would be required:

 

  The number of in-the-money options outstanding in excess of six or more years with a corresponding weighted average exercise price and weighted average contractual remaining term;
  The number of all options outstanding less than six years and underwater options outstanding in excess of six years with a corresponding weighted average exercise price and weighted average contractual remaining term;

 

  The general vesting provisions of option grants; and

 

  The distribution of outstanding option grants with respect to the named executive officers;

 

   

Dilution: Calculate the expected duration of the new share request in addition to all shares currently available for grant under the equity compensation program, based on the company’s three-year average burn rate (or a burn-rate commitment that the company makes for future years). The expected duration will be calculated by multiplying the company’s unadjusted (options and full-value awards accounted on a one-for-one basis) three-year average burn rate by the most recent fiscal year’s weighted average shares outstanding (as used in the company’s calculation of basic EPS) and divide the sum of the new share request and all available shares under the company’s equity compensation program by the product. For example, an expected duration in excess of five years could be considered problematic; and

 

   

Compensation Practices: An evaluation of overall practices could include: (1) stock option repricing provisions, (2) high concentration ratios (of grants to top executives), or (3) additional practices outlined in the Poor Pay Practices policy.

 

B-67


Table of Contents

 

Other Compensation Plans

401(k) Employee Benefit Plans

Vote FOR proposals to implement a 401(k) savings plan for employees.

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

Vote FOR proposals to implement an ESOP or increase authorized shares for existing ESOPs, unless the number of shares allocated to the ESOP is excessive (more than five percent of outstanding shares).

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Qualified Plans

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on qualified employee stock purchase plans. Vote FOR employee stock purchase plans where all of the following apply:

 

   

Purchase price is at least 85 percent of fair market value;

 

   

Offering period is 27 months or less; and

 

   

The number of shares allocated to the plan is ten percent or less of the outstanding shares.

Vote AGAINST qualified employee stock purchase plans where any of the following apply:

 

   

Purchase price is less than 85 percent of fair market value; or

 

   

Offering period is greater than 27 months; or

 

   

The number of shares allocated to the plan is more than ten percent of the outstanding shares.

Employee Stock Purchase Plans — Non-Qualified Plans

Vote CASE-by-CASE on nonqualified employee stock purchase plans. Vote FOR nonqualified employee stock purchase plans with all the following features:

 

   

Broad-based participation (i.e., all employees of the company with the exclusion of individuals with 5 percent or more of beneficial ownership of the company);

 

   

Limits on employee contribution, which may be a fixed dollar amount or expressed as a percent of base salary;

 

   

Company matching contribution up to 25 percent of employee’s contribution, which is effectively a discount of 20 percent from market value;

 

   

No discount on the stock price on the date of purchase since there is a company matching contribution.

Vote AGAINST nonqualified employee stock purchase plans when any of the plan features do not meet the above criteria. If the company matching contribution exceeds 25 percent of employee’s contribution, evaluate the cost of the plan against its allowable cap.

Incentive Bonus Plans and Tax Deductibility Proposals (OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals)

Vote FOR proposals that simply amend shareholder-approved compensation plans to include administrative features or place a cap on the annual grants any one participant may receive to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code.

 

B-68


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR proposals to add performance goals to existing compensation plans to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) unless they are clearly inappropriate.

Votes to amend existing plans to increase shares reserved and to qualify for favorable tax treatment under the provisions of Section 162(m) are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis using a proprietary, quantitative model developed by RMG.

Generally vote FOR cash or cash and stock bonus plans that are submitted to shareholders for the purpose of exempting compensation from taxes under the provisions of Section 162(m) if no increase in shares is requested.

Vote AGAINST proposals if the compensation committee does not fully consist of independent outsiders, as defined in RMG’s classification of director independence.

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

Vote CASE-by-CASE on management proposals seeking approval to exchange/reprice options taking into consideration:

 

   

Historic trading patterns — the stock price should not be so volatile that the options are likely to be back “in-the-money” over the near term;

 

   

Rationale for the re-pricing — was the stock price decline beyond management’s control?

 

   

Is this a value-for-value exchange?

 

   

Are surrendered stock options added back to the plan reserve?

 

   

Option vesting — does the new option vest immediately or is there a black-out period?

 

   

Term of the option — the term should remain the same as that of the replaced option;

 

   

Exercise price — should be set at fair market or a premium to market;

 

   

Participants — executive officers and directors should be excluded.

If the surrendered options are added back to the equity plans for re-issuance, then also take into consideration the company’s total cost of equity plans and its three-year average burn rate.

In addition to the above considerations, evaluate the intent, rationale, and timing of the repricing proposal. The proposal should clearly articulate why the board is choosing to conduct an exchange program at this point in time. Repricing underwater options after a recent precipitous drop in the company’s stock price demonstrates poor timing. Repricing after a recent decline in stock price triggers additional scrutiny and a potential AGAINST vote on the proposal. At a minimum, the decline should not have happened within the past year. Also, consider the terms of the surrendered options, such as the grant date, exercise price and vesting schedule. Grant dates of surrendered options should be far enough back (two to three years) so as not to suggest that repricings are being done to take advantage of short-term downward price movements. Similarly, the exercise price of surrendered options should be above the 52-week high for the stock price.

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

Stock Plans in Lieu of Cash

Vote CASE-by-CASE on plans that provide participants with the option of taking all or a portion of their cash compensation in the form of stock.

 

B-69


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR non-employee director-only equity plans that provide a dollar-for-dollar cash-for-stock exchange.

Vote CASE-by-CASE on plans which do not provide a dollar-for-dollar cash for stock exchange. In cases where the exchange is not dollar-for-dollar, the request for new or additional shares for such equity program will be considered using the binomial option pricing model. In an effort to capture the total cost of total compensation, RMG will not make any adjustments to carve out the in-lieu-of cash compensation.

Transfer Stock Option (TSO) Programs

One-time Transfers: Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from compensation committee members if they fail to submit one-time transfers to shareholders for approval.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on one-time transfers. Vote FOR if:

 

   

Executive officers and non-employee directors are excluded from participating;

 

   

Stock options are purchased by third-party financial institutions at a discount to their fair value using option pricing models such as Black-Scholes or a Binomial Option Valuation or other appropriate financial models;

 

   

There is a two-year minimum holding period for sale proceeds (cash or stock) for all participants.

Additionally, management should provide a clear explanation of why options are being transferred to a third-party institution and whether the events leading up to a decline in stock price were beyond management’s control. A review of the company’s historic stock price volatility should indicate if the options are likely to be back “in-the-money” over the near term.

Ongoing TSO program: Vote AGAINST equity plan proposals if the details of ongoing TSO programs are not provided to shareholders. Since TSOs will be one of the award types under a stock plan, the ongoing TSO program, structure and mechanics must be disclosed to shareholders. The specific criteria to be considered in evaluating these proposals include, but not limited, to the following:

 

   

Eligibility;

 

   

Vesting;

 

   

Bid-price;

 

   

Term of options;

 

   

Cost of the program and impact of the TSOs on company’s total option expense

 

   

Option repricing policy.

Amendments to existing plans that allow for introduction of transferability of stock options should make clear that only options granted post-amendment shall be transferable.

Director Compensation

Equity Plans for Non-Employee Directors

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on compensation plans for non-employee directors, based on the cost of the plans against the company’s allowable cap.

 

B-70


Table of Contents

 

On occasion, director stock plans that set aside a relatively small number of shares when combined with employee or executive stock compensation plans will exceed the allowable cap. Vote for the plan if ALL of the following qualitative factors in the board’s compensation are met and disclosed in the proxy statement:

 

   

Director stock ownership guidelines with a minimum of three times the annual cash retainer.

 

   

Vesting schedule or mandatory holding/deferral period:

 

  A minimum vesting of three years for stock options or restricted stock; or

 

  Deferred stock payable at the end of a three-year deferral period.

 

   

Mix between cash and equity:

 

  A balanced mix of cash and equity, for example 40% cash/60% equity or 50% cash/50% equity; or

 

  If the mix is heavier on the equity component, the vesting schedule or deferral period should be more stringent, with the lesser of five years or the term of directorship.

 

   

No retirement/benefits and perquisites provided to non-employee directors; and

 

   

Detailed disclosure provided on cash and equity compensation delivered to each non-employee director for the most recent fiscal year in a table. The column headers for the table may include the following: name of each non-employee director, annual retainer, board meeting fees, committee retainer, committee-meeting fees, and equity grants.

Director Retirement Plans

Vote AGAINST retirement plans for non-employee directors.

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to eliminate retirement plans for non-employee directors.

Shareholder Proposals on Compensation

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay)

Generally, vote FOR shareholder proposals that call for non-binding shareholder ratification of the compensation of the Named Executive Officers and the accompanying narrative disclosure of material factors provided to understand the Summary Compensation Table.

Compensation Consultants- Disclosure of Board or Company’s utilization

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking disclosure regarding the Company, Board, or Compensation Committee’s use of compensation consultants, such as company name, business relationship(s) and fees paid.

Disclosure/Setting Levels or Types of Compensation for Executives and Directors

Generally, vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking additional disclosure of executive and director pay information, provided the information requested is relevant to shareholders’ needs, would not put the company at a competitive disadvantage relative to its industry, and is not unduly burdensome to the company.

 

B-71


Table of Contents

 

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals seeking to set absolute levels on compensation or otherwise dictate the amount or form of compensation.

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals requiring director fees be paid in stock only.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on all other shareholder proposals regarding executive and director pay, taking into account company performance, pay level versus peers, pay level versus industry, and long-term corporate outlook.

Golden Coffins/Executive Death Benefits

Generally vote FOR proposals calling companies to adopt a policy of obtaining shareholder approval for any future agreements and corporate policies that could oblige the company to make payments or awards following the death of a senior executive in the form of unearned salary or bonuses, accelerated vesting or the continuation in force of unvested equity grants, perquisites and other payments or awards made in lieu of compensation. This would not apply to any benefit programs or equity plan proposals that the broad-based employee population is eligible.

Pay for Superior Performance

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals based on a case-by-case analysis that requests the board establish a pay-for-superior performance standard in the company’s executive compensation plan for senior executives. The proposal has the following principles:

 

   

Sets compensation targets for the Plan’s annual and long-term for incentive the pay components at or below the peer group median;

 

   

Delivers a majority of the Plan’s target long-term compensation through performance-vested, not simply time-vested, equity awards;

 

   

Provides the strategic rationale and relative weightings of the financial and non-financial performance metrics or criteria used in the annual and performance-vested long-term incentive components of the plan;

 

   

Establishes performance targets for each plan financial metric relative to the performance of the company’s peer companies;

 

   

Limits payment under the annual and performance-vested long-term incentive components of the plan to when the company’s performance on its selected financial performance metrics exceeds peer group median performance.

Consider the following factors in evaluating this proposal:

 

   

What aspects of the company’s annual and long-term equity incentive programs are performance driven?

 

   

If the annual and long-term equity incentive programs are performance driven, are the performance criteria and hurdle rates disclosed to shareholders or are they benchmarked against a disclosed peer group?

 

   

Can shareholders assess the correlation between pay and performance based on the current disclosure?

 

   

What type of industry and stage of business cycle does the company belong to?

 

B-72


Table of Contents

 

Performance-Based Awards

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposal requesting that a significant amount of future long-term incentive compensation awarded to senior executives shall be performance-based and requesting that the board adopt and disclose challenging performance metrics to shareholders, based on the following analytical steps:

 

   

First, vote FOR shareholder proposals advocating the use of performance-based equity awards, such as performance contingent options or restricted stock, indexed options or premium-priced options, unless the proposal is overly restrictive or if the company has demonstrated that it is using a “substantial” portion of performance-based awards for its top executives. Standard stock options and performance-accelerated awards do not meet the criteria to be considered as performance-based awards. Further, premium-priced options should have a premium of at least 25 percent and higher to be considered performance-based awards.

 

   

Second, assess the rigor of the company’s performance-based equity program. If the bar set for the performance-based program is too low based on the company’s historical or peer group comparison, generally vote FOR the proposal. Furthermore, if target performance results in an above target payout, vote FOR the shareholder proposal due to program’s poor design. If the company does not disclose the performance metric of the performance-based equity program, vote FOR the shareholder proposal regardless of the outcome of the first step to the test.

In general, vote FOR the shareholder proposal if the company does not meet both of the above two steps.

Pension Plan Income Accounting

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals to exclude pension plan income in the calculation of earnings used in determining executive bonuses/compensation.

Pre-Arranged Trading Plans (10b5-1 Plans)

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for certain principles regarding the use of prearranged trading plans (10b5-1 plans) for executives. These principles include:

 

   

Adoption, amendment, or termination of a 10b5-1 Plan must be disclosed within two business days in a Form 8-K;

 

   

Amendment or early termination of a 10b5-1 Plan is allowed only under extraordinary circumstances, as determined by the board;

 

   

Ninety days must elapse between adoption or amendment of a 10b5-1 Plan and initial trading under the plan;

 

   

Reports on Form 4 must identify transactions made pursuant to a 10b5-1 Plan;

 

   

An executive may not trade in company stock outside the 10b5-1 Plan.

 

   

Trades under a 10b5-1 Plan must be handled by a broker who does not handle other securities transactions for the executive.

Recoup Bonuses

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to recoup unearned incentive bonuses or other incentive payments made to senior executives if it is later determined that the figures upon which incentive compensation is earned

 

B-73


Table of Contents

later turn out to have been in error. This is line with the clawback provision in the Trouble Asset Relief Program. Many companies have adopted policies that permit recoupment in cases where fraud, misconduct, or negligence significantly contributed to a restatement of financial results that led to the awarding of unearned incentive compensation. RMG will take into consideration:

 

   

If the company has adopted a formal recoupment bonus policy;

 

   

If the company has chronic restatement history or material financial problems; or

 

   

If the company’s policy substantially addresses the concerns raised by the proponent.

Severance Agreements for Executives/Golden Parachutes

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requiring that golden parachutes or executive severance agreements be submitted for shareholder ratification, unless the proposal requires shareholder approval prior to entering into employment contracts.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on proposals to ratify or cancel golden parachutes. An acceptable parachute should include, but is not limited to, the following:

 

   

The triggering mechanism should be beyond the control of management;

 

   

The amount should not exceed three times base amount (defined as the average annual taxable W-2 compensation during the five years prior to the year in which the change of control occurs;

 

   

Change-in-control payments should be double-triggered, i.e., (1) after a change in control has taken place, and (2) termination of the executive as a result of the change in control. Change in control is defined as a change in the company ownership structure.

Share Buyback Holding Periods

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals prohibiting executives from selling shares of company stock during periods in which the company has announced that it may or will be repurchasing shares of its stock. Vote FOR the proposal when there is a pattern of abuse by executives exercising options or selling shares during periods of share buybacks.

Stock Ownership or Holding Period Guidelines

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board. While RMG favors stock ownership on the part of directors, the company should determine the appropriate ownership requirement.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals asking companies to adopt policies requiring Named Executive Officers to retain 75% of the shares acquired through compensation plans while employed and/or for two years following the termination of their employment, and to report to shareholders regarding this policy. The following factors will be taken into account:

 

   

Whether the company has any holding period, retention ratio, or officer ownership requirements in place. These should consist of:

 

  Rigorous stock ownership guidelines, or

 

B-74


Table of Contents

 

  A holding period requirement coupled with a significant long-term ownership requirement, or

 

  A meaningful retention ratio,

 

   

Actual officer stock ownership and the degree to which it meets or exceed the proponent’s suggested holding period/retention ratio or the company’s own stock ownership or retention requirements.

 

   

Problematic pay practices, current and past, which may promote a short-term versus a long-term focus.

A rigorous stock ownership guideline should be at least 10x base salary for the CEO, with the multiple declining for other executives. A meaningful retention ratio should constitute at least 50 percent of the stock received from equity awards (on a net proceeds basis) held on a long-term basis, such as the executive’s tenure with the company or even a few years past the executive’s termination with the company.

Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans (SERPs)

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting to put extraordinary benefits contained in SERP agreements to a shareholder vote unless the company’s executive pension plans do not contain excessive benefits beyond what is offered under employee-wide plans.

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting to limit the executive benefits provided under the company’s supplemental executive retirement plan (SERP) by limiting covered compensation to a senior executive’s annual salary and excluding of all incentive or bonus pay from the plan’s definition of covered compensation used to establish such benefits.

Termination of Employment Prior to Severance Payment and Eliminating Accelerated Vesting of Unvested Equity

Vote on a CASE-by-CASE on shareholder proposals seeking a policy requiring termination of employment prior to severance payment, and eliminating accelerated vesting of unvested equity. Change-in-control payouts without loss of job or substantial diminution of job duties (single-triggered) are consider a poor pay practice under RMG policy, and may even result in withheld votes from compensation committee members. The second component of this proposal – related to the elimination of accelerated vesting — requires more careful consideration. The following factors will be taken into regarding this policy.

 

   

The company’s current treatment of equity in change-of-control situations of (i. e. is it double triggered, does it allow for the assumption of equity by acquiring company, the treatment of performance shares.

 

   

Current employment agreements, including potential poor pay practices such as gross-ups embedded in those agreements.

Tax Gross-Up Proposals

Generally vote FOR proposals calling for companies to adopt a policy of not providing tax gross-up payments to executives, except in situations where gross-ups are provided pursuant to a plan, policy, or arrangement applicable to management employees of the company, such as a relocation or expatriate tax equalization policy.

 

B-75


Table of Contents

 

6. Social/Environmental Issues

Overall Approach

When evaluating social and environmental shareholder proposals, RMG considers the following factors:

 

   

Whether adoption of the proposal is likely to enhance or protect shareholder value;

 

   

Whether the information requested concerns business issues that relate to a meaningful percentage of the company’s business as measured by sales, assets, and earnings;

 

   

The degree to which the company’s stated position on the issues raised in the proposal could affect its reputation or sales, or leave it vulnerable to a boycott or selective purchasing;

 

   

Whether the issues presented are more appropriately/effectively dealt with through governmental or company-specific action;

 

   

Whether the company has already responded in some appropriate manner to the request embodied in the proposal;

 

   

Whether the company’s analysis and voting recommendation to shareholders are persuasive;

 

   

What other companies have done in response to the issue addressed in the proposal;

 

   

Whether the proposal itself is well framed and the cost of preparing the report is reasonable;

 

   

Whether implementation of the proposal’s request would achieve the proposal’s objectives;

 

   

Whether the subject of the proposal is best left to the discretion of the board;

 

   

Whether the requested information is available to shareholders either from the company or from a publicly available source; and

 

   

Whether providing this information would reveal proprietary or confidential information that would place the company at a competitive disadvantage.

Animal Welfare

Animal Testing

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to phase out the use of animals in product testing unless:

 

   

The company is conducting animal testing programs that are unnecessary or not required by regulation;

 

   

The company is conducting animal testing when suitable alternatives are commonly accepted and used at industry peers; or

 

   

There are recent, significant fines or litigation related to the company’s treatment of animals.

Animal Welfare Policies

Generally vote FOR proposals seeking a report on the company’s animal welfare standards unless:

 

   

The company has already published a set of animal welfare standards and monitors compliance;

 

   

The company’s standards are comparable to industry peer; and

 

   

There are no recent, significant fines or litigation related to the company’s treatment of animals.

 

B-76


Table of Contents

 

Controlled Atmosphere Killing (CAK)

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting the implementation of CAK methods at company and/or supplier operations unless such methods are required by legislation or generally accepted as the industry standard.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals requesting a report on the feasibility of implementing CAK methods at company and/or supplier operations considering the availability of existing research conducted by the company or industry groups on this topic and any fines or litigation related to current animal processing procedures at the company.

Consumer Issues

Genetically Modified Ingredients

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking suppliers, genetic research companies, restaurants and food retail companies to voluntarily label genetically engineered (GE) ingredients in their products and/or eliminate GE ingredients. The cost of labeling and/or phasing out the use of GE ingredients may not be commensurate with the benefits to shareholders and is an issue better left to regulators.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals asking for a report on the feasibility of labeling products containing GE ingredients taking into account:

 

   

The company’s business and the proportion of it affected by the resolution;

 

   

The quality of the company’s disclosure on GE product labeling, related voluntary initiatives, and how this disclosure compares with industry peer disclosure; and

 

   

Company’s current disclosure on the including feasibility or GE product labeling, including information on the related costs.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals seeking a report on the social, health, and environmental effects of genetically modified organisms (GMOs). Studies of this sort are better undertaken by regulators and the scientific community.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to completely phase out GE ingredients from the company’s products or proposals asking for reports outlining the steps necessary to eliminate GE ingredients from the company’s products. Such resolutions presuppose that there are proven health risks to GE ingredients (an issue better left to regulators) that may outweigh the economic benefits derived from biotechnology.

Consumer Lending

Vote CASE-BY CASE on requests for reports on the company’s lending guidelines and procedures taking into account:

 

   

Whether the company has adequately disclosed mechanisms in place to prevent abusive lending practices;

 

   

Whether the company has adequately disclosed the financial risks of the lending products in question;

 

   

Whether the company has been subject to violations of lending laws or serious lending controversies;

 

   

Peer companies’ policies to prevent abusive lending practices.

 

B-77


Table of Contents

 

Pharmaceutical Pricing, Access to Medicines, and Product Reimportation

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting that companies implement specific price restraints on pharmaceutical products unless the company fails to adhere to legislative guidelines or industry norms in its product pricing.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals requesting that the company evaluate report on their product pricing policies or their access to medicine policies, considering:

 

   

The nature of the company’s business and the potential for reputational and market risk exposure;

 

   

The existing disclosure of relevant policies;

 

   

Deviation from established industry norms;

 

   

The company’s existing, relevant initiatives to provide research and/or products to disadvantaged consumers;

 

   

Whether the proposal focuses on specific products or geographic regions; and

 

   

The potential cost and scope of the requested report.

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting that companies report on the financial and legal impact of their prescription drug reimportation policies unless such information is already publicly disclosed.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting that companies adopt specific policies to encourage or constrain prescription drug reimportation. Such matters are more appropriately the province of legislative activity and may place the company at a competitive disadvantage relative to its peers.

Product Safety and Toxic/Hazardous Materials

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting the company to report on its policies, initiatives/procedures, and oversight mechanisms related to toxic/hazardous materials or product safety in its supply chain, unless:

 

   

The company already discloses similar information through existing reports such as a Supplier Code of Conduct and/or a sustainability report;

 

   

The company has formally committed to the implementation of a toxic/hazardous materials and/or product safety and supply chain reporting and monitoring program based on industry norms or similar standards within a specified time frame; and

 

   

The company has not been recently involved in relevant significant controversies, significant fines, or litigation.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions requesting that companies develop a feasibility assessment to phase-out of certain toxic/hazardous materials, or evaluate and disclose the potential financial and legal risks associated with utilizing certain materials, considering:

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure regarding its product safety policies, initiatives and oversight mechanisms.

 

   

Current regulations in the markets in which the company operates; and

 

   

Recent significant controversies, litigation, or fines stemming from toxic/hazardous materials at the company.

Generally vote AGAINST resolutions requiring that a company reformulate its products.

 

B-78


Table of Contents

 

Tobacco

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions regarding the advertisement of tobacco products, considering:

 

   

Recent related fines, controversies, or significant litigation;

 

   

Whether the company complies with relevant laws and regulations on the marketing of tobacco;

 

   

Whether the company’s advertising restrictions deviate from those of industry peers;

 

   

Whether the company entered into the Master Settlement Agreement, which restricts marketing of tobacco to youth;

 

   

Whether restrictions on marketing to youth extend to foreign countries.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals regarding second-hand smoke, considering;

 

   

Whether the company complies with all laws and regulations;

 

   

The degree that voluntary restrictions beyond those mandated by law might hurt the company’s competitiveness;

 

   

The risk of any health-related liabilities.

Generally vote AGAINST resolutions to cease production of tobacco-related products, to avoid selling products to tobacco companies, to spin-off tobacco-related businesses, or prohibit investment in tobacco equities. Such business decisions are better left to company management or portfolio managers.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals regarding tobacco product warnings. Such decisions are better left to public health authorities.

Diversity

Board Diversity

Generally vote FOR requests for reports on the company’s efforts to diversify the board, unless:

 

   

The gender and racial minority representation of the company’s board is reasonably inclusive in relation to companies of similar size and business; and

 

   

The board already reports on its nominating procedures and gender and racial minority initiatives on the board and within the company.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals asking the company to increase the gender and racial minority representation on its board, taking into account:

 

   

The degree of existing gender and racial minority diversity on the company’s board and among its executive officers;

 

   

The level of gender and racial minority representation that exists at the company’s industry peers;

 

   

The company’s established process for addressing gender and racial minority board representation;

 

   

Whether the proposal includes an overly prescriptive request to amend nominating committee charter language;

 

   

The independence of the company’s nominating committee;

 

   

The company uses an outside search firm to identify potential director nominees; and

 

B-79


Table of Contents

 

   

Whether the company has had recent controversies, fines, or litigation regarding equal employment practices.

Equality of Opportunity

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting a company disclose its diversity policies or initiatives, or proposals requesting disclosure of a company’s comprehensive workforce diversity data, including requests for EEO-1 data, unless:

 

   

The company publicly discloses its comprehensive equal opportunity policies and initiatives;

 

   

The company already publicly discloses comprehensive workforce diversity data; and

 

   

The company has no recent significant EEO-related violations or litigation.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals seeking information on the diversity efforts of suppliers and service providers. Such requests may pose a significant cost and administration burden on the company.

Gender Identity, Sexual Orientation, and Domestic Partner Benefits

Generally vote FOR proposals seeking to amend a company’s EEO statement or diversity policies to prohibit discrimination based on sexual orientation and/or gender identity, unless the change would result in excessive costs for the company.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to extend company benefits to, or eliminate benefits from domestic partners. Decisions regarding benefits should be left to the discretion of the company.

Climate Change and the Environment

Climate Change

Generally vote FOR resolutions requesting that a company disclose information on the impact of climate change on the company’s operations and investments considering:

 

   

The company already provides current, publicly-available information on the impacts that climate change may have on the company as well as associated company policies and procedures to address related risks and/or opportunities;

 

   

The company’s disclosure level of disclosure is at least of comparable to that of industry peers; and

 

   

There are no significant, controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company’s environmental performance.

Concentrated Animal Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

Generally vote FOR resolutions requesting companies report to shareholders on the risks and liabilities associated with CAFOs unless:

 

   

The company has publicly disclosed its environmental management policies for its corporate and contract farming operations, including compliance monitoring; and The company publicly discloses company and supplier farm environmental performance data; or

 

B-80


Table of Contents

 

   

The company does not have company-owned CAFOs and does not directly source from contract farm CAFOs.

Energy Efficiency

Generally vote FOR on proposals requesting a company report on its comprehensive energy efficiency policies, unless:

 

   

The company complies with applicable energy efficiency regulations and laws, and discloses its participation in energy efficiency policies and programs, including disclosure of benchmark data, targets, and performance measures; or

 

   

The proponent requests adoption of specific energy efficiency goals within specific timelines.

Facility and Operational Safety/Security

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions requesting that companies report on safety and/or security risks associated with their operations and/or facilities, considering:

 

   

The company’s compliance with applicable regulations and guidelines;

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure regarding its security and safety policies, procedures, and compliance monitoring; and,

 

   

The existence of recent, significant violations, fines, or controversy regarding the safety and security of the company’s operations and/or facilities.

Greenhouse Gas (GHG) Emissions

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting a report on greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions from company operations and/or products and operations, unless:

 

   

The company already provides current, publicly-available information on the impacts that GHG emissions may have on the company as well as associated company policies and procedures to address related risks and/or opportunities;

 

   

The company’s level of disclosure is comparable to that of industry peers; and

 

   

There are no significant, controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company’s GHG emissions.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals that call for the adoption of GHG reduction goals from products and operations, taking into account:

 

   

Overly prescriptive requests for the reduction in GHG emissions by specific amounts or within a specific time frame;

 

   

Whether company disclosure lags behind industry peers;

 

   

Whether the company has been the subject of recent, significant violations, fines, litigation, or controversy related to GHG emissions;

 

   

The feasibility of reduction of GHGs given the company’s product line and current technology and;

 

B-81


Table of Contents

 

   

Whether the company already provides meaningful disclosure on GHG emissions from its products and operations.

Operations in Protected Areas

Generally vote FOR requests for reports on potential environmental damage as a result of company operations in protected regions unless:

 

   

Operations in the specified regions are not permitted by current laws or regulations;

 

   

The company does not currently have operations or plans to develop operations in these protected regions; or,

 

   

The company’s disclosure of its operations and environmental policies in these regions is comparable to industry peers.

Recycling

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to adopt a comprehensive recycling strategy, taking into account:

 

   

The nature of the company’s business;

 

   

The extent that peer companies are recycling;

 

   

The timetable prescribed by the proposal and the costs and methods of implementation;

 

   

Whether the company has a poor environmental track record, such as violations of applicable regulations.

Renewable Energy

Generally vote FOR requests for reports on the feasibility of developing renewable energy resources unless the report is duplicative of existing disclosure or irrelevant to the company’s line of business.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals requesting that the company invest in renewable energy resources. Such decisions are best left to management’s evaluation of the feasibility and financial impact that such programs may have on the company.

General Corporate Issues

Charitable Contributions

Vote AGAINST proposals restricting the company from making charitable contributions. Charitable contributions are generally useful for assisting worthwhile causes and for creating goodwill in the community. In the absence of bad faith, self-dealing, or gross negligence, management should determine which, and if, contributions are in the best interests of the company.

 

B-82


Table of Contents

 

Environmental, Social, and Governance (ESG) Compensation-Related Proposals

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to link, or report on linking, executive compensation to environmental and social criteria (such as corporate downsizings, customer or employee satisfaction, community involvement, human rights, environmental performance, or predatory lending) as the practice of linking executive compensation and such criteria is currently the exception rather than the norm and there appears to be a lack of widely-accepted standards regarding the implementation of effective linkages between executive compensation and corporate non-financial performance. However, the following factors will be considered:

 

   

Whether the company has significant and persistent controversies or violations regarding social and/or environmental issues;

 

   

Whether the company has management systems and oversight mechanisms in place regarding its social and environmental performance;

 

   

The degree to which industry peers have incorporated similar non-financial performance criteria in their executive compensation practices; and

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure regarding its environmental and social performance.

Generally vote AGAINST proposals calling for an analysis of the pay disparity between corporate executives and other non-executive employees. The value of the information sought by such proposals is unclear.

Health Pandemics

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on requests for reports outlining the impact of health pandemics (such as HIV/AIDS, Malaria, Tuberculosis, and Avian Flu) on the company’s operations and how the company is responding to the situation, taking into account:

 

   

The scope of the company’s operations in the affected/relevant area(s);

 

   

The company’s existing healthcare policies, including benefits and healthcare access; and

 

   

Company donations to relevant healthcare providers.

Vote AGAINST proposals asking companies to establish, implement, and report on a standard of response to health pandemics (such as HIV/AIDS, Malaria, Tuberculosis, and Avian Flu), unless the company has significant operations in the affected markets and has failed to adopt policies and/or procedures to address these issues comparable to those of industry peers.

Lobbying Expenditures/Initiatives

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals requesting information on a company’s lobbying initiatives, considering:

 

   

Significant controversies, fines, or litigation surrounding a company’s public policy activities,

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure on lobbying strategy, and

 

   

The impact that the policy issue may have on the company’s business operations.

 

B-83


Table of Contents

 

Political Contributions and Trade Associations Spending

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking the company to affirm political nonpartisanship in the workplace so long as:

 

   

There are no recent, significant controversies, fines or litigation regarding the company’s political contributions or trade association spending; and

 

   

The company has procedures in place to ensure that employee contributions to company-sponsored political action committees (PACs) are strictly voluntary and prohibits coercion.

Vote AGAINST proposals to publish in newspapers and public media the company’s political contributions. Such publications could present significant cost to the company without providing commensurate value to shareholders.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to improve the disclosure of a company’s political contributions and trade association spending considering:

 

   

Recent significant controversy or litigation related to the company’s political contributions or governmental affairs; and

 

   

The public availability of a company policy on political contributions and trade association spending including information on the types of organizations supported, the business rationale for supporting these organizations, and the oversight and compliance procedures related to such expenditures of corporate assets.

Vote AGAINST proposals barring the company from making political contributions. Businesses are affected by legislation at the federal, state, and local level and barring political contributions can put the company at a competitive disadvantage.

Vote AGAINST proposals asking for a list of company executives, directors, consultants, legal counsels, lobbyists, or investment bankers that have prior government service and whether such service had a bearing on the business of the company. Such a list would be burdensome to prepare without providing any meaningful information to shareholders.

International Issues, Labor Issues, and Human Rights

Community Social and Environmental Impact Assessments

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on requests for reports outlining policies and/or the potential (community) social and/or environmental impact of company operations considering:

 

   

Current disclosure of applicable policies and risk assessment report(s) and risk management procedures;

 

   

The impact of regulatory non-compliance, litigation, remediation, or reputational loss that may be associated with failure to manage the company’s operations in question, including the management of relevant community and stakeholder relations;

 

   

The nature, purpose, and scope of the company’s operations in the specific region(s);

 

   

The degree to which company policies and procedures are consistent with industry norms; and

 

   

Scope of the resolution.

 

B-84


Table of Contents

 

Foreign Military Sales/Offsets

Vote AGAINST reports on foreign military sales or offsets. Such disclosures may involve sensitive and confidential information. Moreover, companies must comply with government controls and reporting on foreign military sales.

Internet Privacy and Censorship

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on resolutions requesting the disclosure and implementation of Internet privacy and censorship policies and procedures considering:

 

   

The level of disclosure of company policies and procedures relating to privacy, freedom of speech, Internet censorship, and government monitoring of the Internet;

 

   

Engagement in dialogue with governments and/or relevant groups with respect to the Internet and the free flow of information;

 

   

The scope of business involvement and of investment in markets that maintain government censorship or monitoring of the Internet;

 

   

The market-specific laws or regulations applicable to Internet censorship or monitoring that may be imposed on the company; and,

 

   

The level of controversy or litigation related to the company’s international human rights policies and procedures.

Labor and Human Rights Standards

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting a report on company or company supplier labor and/or human rights standards and policies unless such information is already publicly disclosed.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to implement company or company supplier labor and/or human rights standards and policies, considering:

 

   

The degree to which existing relevant policies and practices are disclosed;

 

   

Whether or not existing relevant policies are consistent with internationally recognized standards;

 

   

Whether company facilities and those of its suppliers are monitored and how;

 

   

Company participation in fair labor organizations or other internationally recognized human rights initiatives;

 

   

Scope and nature of business conducted in markets known to have higher risk of workplace labor/human rights abuse;

 

   

Recent, significant company controversies, fines, or litigation regarding human rights at the company or its suppliers;

 

   

The scope of the request; and

 

   

Deviation from industry sector peer company standards and practices.

 

B-85


Table of Contents

 

MacBride Principles

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to endorse or increase activity on the MacBride Principles, unless:

 

   

The company has formally been found to be out of compliance with relevant Northern Ireland fair employment laws and regulations;

 

   

Failure to implement the MacBride Principles would put the company in an inconsistent position and/or at a competitive disadvantage compared with industry peers;

 

   

Failure to implement the MacBride Principles would subject the company to excessively negative financial impacts due to laws that some municipalities have passed regarding their contracting operations and companies that have not implemented the MacBride Principles; or

 

   

The company has had recent, significant controversies, fines or litigation regarding religious-based employment discrimination in Northern Ireland.

Nuclear and Depleted Uranium Weapons

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking a company to cease production or report on the risks associated with the use of depleted uranium munitions or nuclear weapons components and delivery systems, including disengaging from current and proposed contracts. Such contracts are monitored by government agencies, serve multiple military and non-military uses, and withdrawal from these contracts could have a negative impact on the company’s business.

     

Operations in High Risk Markets

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on requests for a report on a company’s potential financial reputational risks associated with operations in “high-risk” markets, such as a terrorism-sponsoring state or politically/socially unstable region, taking into account:

 

   

The nature, purpose, and scope of the operations and business involved that could be affected by social or political disruption;

 

   

Current disclosure of applicable risk assessment(s) and risk management procedures;

 

   

Compliance with U.S. sanctions and laws;

 

   

Consideration of other international policies, standards, and laws; and

 

   

Whether the company has been recently involved in recent, significant controversies, fines or litigation related to its operations in “high-risk” markets.

     

Outsourcing/Offshoring

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals calling for companies to report on the risks associated with outsourcing/plant closures, considering:

 

   

Controversies surrounding operations in the relevant market(s);

 

   

The value of the requested report to shareholders;

 

B-86


Table of Contents

 

   

The company’s current level of disclosure of relevant information on outsourcing and plant closure procedures; and

 

   

The company’s existing human rights standards relative to industry peers.

     

Sustainability

Sustainability Reporting

Generally vote FOR proposals requesting the company to report on its policies, initiatives, and oversight mechanisms related to social, economic, and environmental sustainability, unless:

 

   

The company already discloses similar information through existing reports or policies such as an Environment, Health, and Safety (EHS) report; a comprehensive Code of Corporate Conduct; and/or a Diversity Report; or

 

   

The company has formally committed to the implementation of a reporting program based on Global Reporting Initiative (GRI) guidelines or a similar standard within a specified time frame

     

7. Mutual Fund Proxies

Election of Directors

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the election of directors and trustees, following the same guidelines for uncontested directors for public company shareholder meetings. However, mutual fund boards do not usually have compensation committees, so do not withhold for the lack of this committee.

     

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on conversion proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance as a closed-end fund;

 

   

Market in which the fund invests;

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the discount; and

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals.

     

Proxy Contests

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proxy contests, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance relative to its peers;

 

   

Market in which fund invests;

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the issues;

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals;

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents;

 

B-87


Table of Contents
   

Independence of directors;

 

   

Experience and skills of director candidates;

 

   

Governance profile of the company;

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment.

     

Investment Advisory Agreements

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on investment advisory agreements, considering the following factors:

 

   

Proposed and current fee schedules;

 

   

Fund category/investment objective;

 

   

Performance benchmarks;

 

   

Share price performance as compared with peers;

 

   

Resulting fees relative to peers;

 

   

Assignments (where the advisor undergoes a change of control).

     

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares

Vote FOR the establishment of new classes or series of shares.

     

Preferred Stock Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the authorization for or increase in preferred shares, considering the following factors:

 

   

Stated specific financing purpose;

 

   

Possible dilution for common shares;

 

   

Whether the shares can be used for antitakeover purposes.

     

1940 Act Policies

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on policies under the Investment Advisor Act of 1940, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness;

 

   

Regulatory developments;

 

   

Current and potential returns; and

 

   

Current and potential risk.

Generally vote FOR these amendments as long as the proposed changes do not fundamentally alter the investment focus of the fund and do comply with the current SEC interpretation.

     

 

B-88


Table of Contents

 

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Nonfundamental Restriction

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to change a fundamental restriction to a non-fundamental restriction, considering the following factors:

 

   

The fund’s target investments;

 

   

The reasons given by the fund for the change; and

 

   

The projected impact of the change on the portfolio.

     

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Nonfundamental

Vote AGAINST proposals to change a fund’s fundamental investment objective to non-fundamental.

     

Name Change Proposals

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on name change proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Political/economic changes in the target market;

 

   

Consolidation in the target market; and

 

   

Current asset composition.

     

Change in Fund’s Subclassification

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on changes in a fund’s sub-classification, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness;

 

   

Current and potential returns;

 

   

Risk of concentration;

 

   

Consolidation in target industry.

     

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to dispose of assets, to terminate or liquidate, considering the following factors:

 

   

Strategies employed to salvage the company;

 

   

The fund’s past performance;

 

   

The terms of the liquidation.

     

 

B-89


Table of Contents

 

Changes to the Charter Document

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on changes to the charter document, considering the following factors:

 

   

The degree of change implied by the proposal;

 

   

The efficiencies that could result;

 

   

The state of incorporation;

 

   

Regulatory standards and implications.

Vote AGAINST any of the following changes:

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to reorganize or terminate the trust or any of its series;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement for amendments to the new declaration of trust;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to amend the fund’s management contract, allowing the contract to be modified by the investment manager and the trust management, as permitted by the 1940 Act;

 

   

Allow the trustees to impose other fees in addition to sales charges on investment in a fund, such as deferred sales charges and redemption fees that may be imposed upon redemption of a fund’s shares;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to engage in and terminate subadvisory arrangements;

 

   

Removal of shareholder approval requirement to change the domicile of the fund.

     

Changing the Domicile of a Fund

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on re-incorporations, considering the following factors:

 

   

Regulations of both states;

 

   

Required fundamental policies of both states;

 

   

The increased flexibility available.

     

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval

Vote AGAINST proposals authorizing the board to hire/terminate subadvisors without shareholder approval.

     

Distribution Agreements

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on distribution agreement proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fees charged to comparably sized funds with similar objectives;

 

   

The proposed distributor’s reputation and past performance;

 

   

The competitiveness of the fund in the industry;

 

   

The terms of the agreement.

     

 

B-90


Table of Contents

 

Master-Feeder Structure

Vote FOR the establishment of a master-feeder structure.

     

Mergers

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on merger proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Resulting fee structure;

 

   

Performance of both funds;

 

   

Continuity of management personnel;

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights.

     

Shareholder Proposals for Mutual Funds

Establish Director Ownership Requirement

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a specific minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board.

    

Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on shareholder proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses. When supporting the dissidents, vote FOR the reimbursement of the proxy solicitation expenses.

     

Terminate the Investment Advisor

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on proposals to terminate the investment advisor, considering the following factors:

 

   

Performance of the fund’s Net Asset Value (NAV);

 

   

The fund’s history of shareholder relations;

 

   

The performance of other funds under the advisor’s management.

     

 

B-91


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

[LOGO] 

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

RMG Governance Services

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

Copyright © 2009 by RiskMetrics Group. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.


Table of Contents

 

General Policies

 

Financial Results/Director and Auditor Reports

     B-94   

Appointment of Auditors and Auditor Compensation

     B-95   

Appointment of Internal Statutory Auditors

     B-96   

Allocation of Income

     B-97   

Amendments to Articles of Association

     B-99   

Change in Company Fiscal Term

     B-100   

Lower Disclosure Threshold for Stock Ownership

     B-101   

Amend Quorum Requirements

     B-102   

Transact Other Business

     B-103   

International Classification of Directors

     B-107   

Director Compensation

     B-109   

Director, Officer, and Auditor Indemnification and Liability Provisions

     B-112   

Board Structure

     B-113   

Capital Systems

     B-115   

Reduction of Capital

     B-119   

Capital Structures

     B-121   

Preferred Stock

     B-122   

Debt Issuance Requests

     B-124   

Pledging of Assets for Debt

     B-125   

Increase in Borrowing Powers

     B-126   

Reissuance of Shares Repurchased

     B-128   

Capitalization of Reserves for Bonus Issues/Increase In Par Value

     B-129   

Reorganizations/Restructurings

     B-130   

Mergers and Acquisitions

     B-131   

Mandatory Takeover Bid Waivers

     B-133   

Reincorporation Proposals

     B-134   

Expansion of Business Activities

     B-135   

Related-Party Transactions

     B-136   

Antitakeover Mechanisms

     B-145   

Shareholder Proposals

     B-146   

Compensation Systems — Europe

  

Election of Former CEO as Chairman of the Board — Europe

  

 

B-93


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Financial Results/Director and Auditor Reports

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR approval of financial statements and director and auditor reports, unless:

 

   

There are concerns about the accounts presented or audit procedures used; or

 

   

The company is not responsive to shareholder questions about specific items that should be publicly disclosed.

Discussion

Most companies around the world submit these reports to shareholders for approval, and this is one of the first items on most agendas. The official financial statements and director and auditor reports are valuable documents when evaluating a company’s annual performance. The director report usually includes a review of the company’s performance during the year, justification of dividend levels and profits or losses, special events such as acquisitions or disposals, and future plans for the company.

The auditor report discloses any irregularities or problems with the company’s finances. While a qualified report by itself is not sufficient reason to oppose this resolution, it raises cautionary flags of which shareholders should be aware. Most auditor reports are unqualified, meaning that in the auditor’s opinion, the company’s financial statements are made in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

When evaluating a company’s financial statements, RMG looks at debt/equity levels on the balance sheet, historical sales and earnings performance, dividend history and payout ratios, and the company’s performance within its own country and relative to similar companies in its industry. Unless there are major concerns about the accuracy of the financial statements or the director or auditor reports, RMG recommends approval of this item.

 

B-94


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Appointment of Auditors and Auditor Compensation

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR the reelection of auditors and proposals authorizing the board to fix auditor fees, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the accounts presented or the audit procedures used;

 

 

   

The auditors are being changed without explanation; or

 

 

   

Non-audit-related fees are substantial or are routinely in excess of standard annual audit-related fees.

 

Vote AGAINST the appointment of external auditors if they have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company.

Discussion

Most major companies around the world use one of the major international auditing firms to conduct their audits. As such, concerns about the quality and objectivity of the audit are minimal, and the reappointment of the auditor is usually a routine matter. Audit fees tend to be highly competitive and vary little between companies. However, if a company proposes a new auditor or an auditor resigns and does not seek reelection, companies should offer an explanation to shareholders. If shareholders request an explanation for a change in auditor and the company or retiring auditor fails to provide one, RMG recommends a vote against the election of a new auditor. If an explanation is otherwise unavailable, RMG recommends that shareholders abstain on this item.

Many countries also require the appointment of censors, or special auditors who ensure that the board and management are in compliance with the company’s articles. The censors’ role is purely advisory in nature. Proposals to appoint censors are routine, as the censors usually act as a secondary auditor for special audit requirements.

The practice of auditors providing non-audit services to companies is problematic. While large auditors may have effective internal barriers to ensure that there are no conflicts of interest, an auditor’s ability to remain objective becomes questionable when fees paid to the auditor for non-audit services such as management consulting, general bookkeeping, and special situation audits exceed the standard annual audit fees. While some compensation for non-audit services is customary, the importance of maintaining the independence of the auditor is paramount. If fees from non-audit services become significant without any clear safeguards against conflicts of interest, RMG recommends opposing the auditor’s reappointment.

 

B-95


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Appointment of Internal Statutory Auditors

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR the appointment or reelection of statutory auditors, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the statutory reports presented or the audit procedures used;

 

   

Questions exist concerning any of the statutory auditors being appointed; or

 

   

The auditors have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company.

Discussion

The appointment of internal statutory auditors is a routine request for companies in Latin America, Italy, Spain, Portugal, Japan, Korea, and Russia. The statutory auditing board is usually composed of three to five members, including a group chairman and two alternate members, all of whom are expected to be independent. In addition to the regular duty of verifying corporate accounts, the auditor board is responsible for supervising management and ensuring compliance with the law and articles of association. The auditors must perform an audit of the accounts every three months and present to shareholders a report on the balance sheet at the AGM. For most countries, the auditors are elected annually and may seek reelection. RMG recommends supporting the appointment of statutory auditors unless there are serious concerns about the reports presented or questions about an auditor’s qualifications.

 

B-96


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Allocation of Income

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR approval of the allocation of income, unless:

 

   

The dividend payout ratio has been consistently below 30 percent without adequate explanation; or

 

   

The payout is excessive given the company’s financial position.

Discussion

Many countries require shareholders to approve the allocation of income generated during the year. These proposals usually, but not always, contain an allocation to dividends. When determining the acceptability of this proposal, RMG focuses primarily on the payout ratio. Payouts of less than 30 percent or more than 100 percent are a trigger for further analysis. The minimum level of 30 percent is based on a review of international practice. Payouts of more than 100 percent are a signal that the company is dipping into reserves to make the payment.

Further analysis of payout ratios should include the following: an examination of historical payouts to determine if there is a long-term pattern of low payouts, exceptional events that may have artificially modified earnings for the year, the condition of a company’s balance sheet, comparisons with similar companies both domestically and internationally, and the classification of the company as growth or mature.

Justifications for extreme payouts must be reviewed carefully. If the company has an adequate explanation for a certain payout, RMG supports the income allocation as proposed. However, if a company has a pattern of low payouts, fails to adequately justify the retention of capital, and is not experiencing above-average growth, RMG recommends opposing the proposal. A vote against the payout is also recommended if a company appears to be maintaining an excessive payout that may affect its long-term health.

 

B-97


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Stock (Scrip) Dividend Alternative

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR most stock (scrip) dividend proposals.

Vote AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

Discussion

Stock (scrip) dividend alternatives, whereby shareholders are offered the option of receiving their dividend payment in the form of fully paid ordinary shares, are common proposals worldwide. While dividend payments in the form of shares in lieu of cash do not immediately add to shareholder value, they allow companies to retain cash and to strengthen the position and commitment of long-term shareholders. RMG opposes stock dividend proposals that do not allow a cash option unless management shows that the cash outflow is detrimental to the company’s health and to long-term shareholder value.

 

B-98


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Amendments to Articles of Association

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote amendments to the articles of association on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to amend a company’s articles of association are usually motivated by changes in the company’s legal and regulatory environment, although evolution of general business practice can also prompt amendments to articles. Such proposals are especially common whenever stock exchange listing rules are revised, new legislation is passed, or a court case exposes the need to close loopholes.

Amendments to articles range from minor spelling changes to the adoption of an entirely new set of articles. While the majority of such requests are of a technical and administrative nature, minor changes in wording can have a significant impact on corporate governance. As such, RMG carefully scrutinizes any changes to a company’s articles.

From a company’s perspective, it is often more efficient to adopt a new set of articles than to introduce numerous amendments. However, bundling changes that treat different provisions of the articles into one voting item prevents shareholders from separating items of concern from routine changes. By leaving a shareholder with an all-or-nothing choice, bundling allows companies to include negative provisions along with positive or neutral changes.

When reviewing new or revised articles, RMG classifies each change according to its potential impact on shareholder value and then weighs the package as a whole. The presence of one strongly negative change may warrant a recommendation against the resolution. In assigning these classifications, RMG is not concerned with the nature of the article being amended, but rather focuses on whether the proposed change improves or worsens the existing provision.

The final criterion on which RMG bases its decision is whether failure to pass a resolution would cause an immediate loss of shareholder value. In such cases, RMG supports even a bundled resolution that includes negative changes.

 

B-99


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Change in Company Fiscal Term

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR resolutions to change a company’s fiscal term unless a company’s motivation for the change is to postpone its AGM.

Discussion

Companies routinely seek shareholder approval to change their fiscal year end. This is a decision best left to management. RMG opposes this resolution only if the company is changing its year end to postpone its AGM. Most countries require companies to hold their AGM within a certain period of time after the close of the fiscal year. If a company is embroiled in a controversy, it might seek approval to amend its fiscal year end at an EGM to avoid controversial issues at an AGM. RMG opposes the change in year end in these cases.

 

B-100


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Lower Disclosure Threshold for Stock Ownership

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote AGAINST resolutions to lower the stock ownership disclosure threshold below 5 percent unless specific reasons exist to implement a lower threshold.

Discussion

RMG’s recommended level for ownership disclosure is 5 percent. A level below that does not add substantially to shareholders’ interests and is often only a pretext for an antitakeover defense. A lower level also requires a greater number of shareholders to disclose their ownership, causing a greater burden to shareholders and to the company. Positions of more than 5 percent are significant, however, and this is the standard that the U.S. SEC uses.

In certain cases, shareholders may want to know of smaller positions — at a troubled company likely to be put in play, for example. RMG examines these companies to determine if these lower thresholds would benefit shareholders.

 

B-101


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Amend Quorum Requirements

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to amend quorum requirements for shareholder meetings on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Quorum requirements differ widely by market. In the United States, for instance, a quorum of a majority of the outstanding shares is the norm. In many global markets, however, the percentage of shares represented at meetings is not as high as in the United States. Indeed, many companies incorporated in markets outside the United States have difficulty attaining a quorum.

Proposals to amend the quorum requirement are evaluated on a case-by-case basis based on market norms, the company’s reasons for the change, and the company’s ownership structure. With respect to the latter, companies that have a substantial shareholder or shareholder group should set their quorum requirement well above the percentage of shares owned by such shareholder or shareholder group. Quorum requirements are intended to ensure that a broad range of shareholders are represented at meetings. Setting a quorum requirement that is too low, whether in absolute terms or relative to the holdings of a large shareholder, undermines this purpose. A low quorum requirement is of particular concern in markets where resolutions are decided on the basis of either shares present and entitled to vote at a meeting or votes cast at the meeting; in such cases, once a quorum is attained the shares present, regardless of whether they are representative of the entire body of shareholders, will be able to decide the matters under consideration at the meeting.

 

B-102


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Transact Other Business

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote AGAINST other business when it appears as a voting item.

Discussion

This item provides a forum for questions and any other resolutions that may be brought up at the meeting. In most countries the item is a formality and does not require a shareholder vote, but companies in certain countries include other business as a voting item. Because shareholders who vote by proxy cannot know what issues will be raised under this item, RMG cannot recommend that shareholders approve this request when asked for a vote. While RMG recognizes that in most cases this item is a formality or includes discussion that will have no impact on shareholders, shareholders cannot risk the negative consequences of voting in advance on an item for which information has not been disclosed.

 

B-103


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Director Elections

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR management nominees in the election of directors, unless:

 

   

Adequate disclosure has not been provided in a timely manner;

 

   

There are clear concerns over questionable finances or restatements;

 

   

There have been questionable transactions with conflicts of interest;

 

   

There are any records of abuses against minority shareholder interests; and

 

   

The board fails to meet minimum corporate governance standards.

Vote FOR individual nominees unless there are specific concerns about the individual, such as criminal wrongdoing or breach of fiduciary responsibilities.

Vote AGAINST individual directors if repeated absences at board meetings have not been explained (in countries where this information is disclosed).

Vote FOR employee and/or labor representatives if they sit on either the audit or compensation committee and are required by law to be on those committees. Vote AGAINST employee and/or labor representatives if they sit on either the audit or compensation committee, if they are not required to be on those committees.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis for contested elections of directors, e.g. the election of shareholder nominees or the dismissal of incumbent directors, determining which directors are best suited to add value for shareholders.

Please see the International Classification of Directors here.

Discussion

RMG considers director elections to be one of the most important voting decisions that shareholders make, especially because shareholders are only given the opportunity to review their companies’ operations once a year at the AGM. Thus, if detailed information on boards or nominees is available, analysis to the highest degree possible is warranted. Directors function as the representatives of shareholders throughout the year and are therefore a crucial avenue of ongoing influence on management.

Levels of disclosure regarding directors vary widely. In some countries, such as the United Kingdom, Canada, and Australia, companies publish detailed information such as director biographies, share ownership, and related information that aids shareholders in determining the level of director independence. In many other countries, the only information available on directors is their names, while still other countries disclose no information at all. In cases where detailed information about directors is not available, it would be counterproductive to vote against directors on the basis of a lack of information. Opposition to specific nominees or boards should be supported by specific problems or concerns.

RMG will recommend against the routine election of directors taking into consideration the absence of adequate or timely disclosure, questionable finances or restatements, questionable transactions with conflicts of interest, any record of abuses against minority shareholder interests, bundling of director elections, and/or any other egregious corporate governance practices.

 

B-104


Table of Contents

Boards in many countries are divided into two or more classes that are elected on a staggered basis. This system of classified boards is common across the world. Only Canadian companies routinely elect the entire board on an annual basis, but even in Canada companies may classify their board if an appropriate amendment is made to the articles. In certain countries, executive directors may be appointed for terms of up to five years, and a company’s articles may give executive directors protected board seats under which they are not subject to shareholder election. RMG opposes protected board seats and preferential treatment of executive directors.

When reviewing director election proposals, RMG examines board composition, company performance, and any negative views or information on either the company or individual directors. RMG determines the number of executive directors, independent non-executive directors, and non-independent non-executive directors on the board, the existence and composition of board committees, and the independence of the chairman. A non-independent non-executive director is defined as one who represents a major shareholder; has significant commercial contacts with the company as a legal counsel, auditor, or consultant; has held executive positions within the company in the past; or is related to the founding family, another board member, or a top executive. In cases where board composition is of concern, the company’s general health and its recent financial performance may play a part in the evaluation of directors. Individual director information is also considered, including share ownership among director nominees.

RMG also takes into account the attendance records of directors when such information is provided to shareholders, using a benchmark attendance rate of 75 percent of board meetings. If an individual director fails to attend at least 75 percent of board meetings for two or more consecutive years, RMG makes further inquiries to the company regarding the absences. RMG recommends withholding votes against the director unless the company has provided a reasonable explanation for the absences. International companies tend to have directors who reside in other countries on their boards, making attendance difficult. While RMG understands the difficulties imposed on such directors, failing to attend meetings prevents directors from fulfilling their fiduciary obligations and adequately representing shareholder interests. Other business obligations and conflicting travel schedules are not acceptable reasons for consistently poor attendance records. RMG supports the use of teleconferencing and videoconferencing to cope with the increasing time and travel demands faced by directors in global business.

Statements of corporate governance practices are also helpful in reviewing director election proposals, but only in a few countries are these routinely included as part of the annual report, usually as a listing requirement of the major stock exchange. These reports are required in Australia, Canada, South Africa, and the United Kingdom.

Voting on Director Nominees in Contested Elections

For shareholder nominees, RMG places the persuasive burden on the nominee or the proposing shareholder to prove that they are better suited to serve on the board than management’s nominees. Serious consideration of shareholder nominees will be given only if there are clear and compelling reasons for the nominee to join the board. These nominees must also demonstrate a clear ability to contribute positively to board deliberations; some nominees may have hidden or narrow agendas and may unnecessarily contribute to divisiveness among directors.

The major decision factors are:

 

   

Company performance relative to its peers

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents

 

   

Independence of directors/nominees

 

   

Experience and skills of board candidates

 

   

Governance profile of the company

 

B-105


Table of Contents

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment

 

   

Responsiveness to shareholders

 

   

Whether a takeover offer has been rebuffed

When analyzing proxy contests/ shareholder nominees, RMG focuses on two central questions: (1) Have the dissidents proved that board change is warranted? and (2) if so, are the dissident board nominees likely to effect positive change (i.e., maximize long-term shareholder value)?

 

B-106


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

International Classification of Directors

 

Executive Director

 

   

Employee or executive of the company;

 

 

   

Any director who is classified as a non-executive, but receives salary, fees, bonus, and/or other benefits that are in line with the highest-paid executives of the company.

 

Non-Independent Non-Executive Director (NED)

 

   

Any director who is attested by the board to be a non-independent NED;

 

 

   

Any director specifically designated as a representative of a significant shareholder of the company;

 

 

   

Any director who is also an employee or executive of a significant shareholder of the company;

 

 

   

Beneficial owner (direct or indirect) of at least 10 percent of the company’s stock, either in economic terms or in voting rights (this may be aggregated if voting power is distributed among more than one member of a defined group, e.g., members of a family that beneficially own less than 10 percent individually, but collectively own more than 10 percent), unless market best practice dictates a lower ownership and/or disclosure threshold (and in other special market-specific circumstances);

 

 

   

Government representative;

 

 

   

Currently provides (or a relative¹ provides) professional services² to the company, to an affiliate of the company, or to an individual officer of the company or of one of its affiliates in excess of $10,000 per year;

 

 

   

Represents customer, supplier, creditor, banker, or other entity with which company maintains transactional/commercial relationship (unless company discloses information to apply a materiality test³);

 

 

   

Any director who has conflicting or cross-directorships with executive directors or the chairman of the company;

 

 

   

Relative¹ of current employee of the company or its affiliates;

 

 

   

Relative¹ of former executive of the company or its affiliates;

 

 

   

A new appointee elected other than by a formal process through the general meeting (such as a contractual appointment by a substantial shareholder);

 

 

   

Founder/co-founder/member of founding family but not currently an employee;

 

 

   

Former executive (five-year cooling off period);

 

 

   

Years of service will NOT be a determining factor unless it is recommended best practice in a market:

 

 

   

9 years (from the date of election) in the United Kingdom and Ireland;

 

 

   

12 years in European markets;

 

 

   

7 years in Russia.

 

Independent NED

 

   

No material4 connection, either direct or indirect, to the company other than a board seat.

 

 

B-107


Table of Contents

 

Employee Representative

 

   

Represents employees or employee shareholders of the company (classified as “employee representative” but considered a non-independent NED).

Footnotes:

 

1

“Relative” follows the SEC’s proposed definition of “immediate family members” which covers spouses, parents, children, step-parents, step-children, siblings, in-laws, and any person (other than a tenant or employee) sharing the household of any director, nominee for director, executive officer, or significant shareholder of the company.

2

Professional services can be characterized as advisory in nature and generally include the following: investment banking/financial advisory services; commercial banking (beyond deposit services); investment services; insurance services; accounting/audit services; consulting services; marketing services; and legal services. The case of participation in a banking syndicate by a non-lead bank should be considered a transaction (and hence subject to the associated materiality test) rather than a professional relationship.

3

If the company makes or receives annual payments exceeding the greater of $200,000 or 5 percent of the recipient’s gross revenues. (The recipient is the party receiving the financial proceeds from the transaction.)

4

For purposes of RMG’s director independence classification, “material” will be defined as a standard of relationship (financial, personal, or otherwise) that a reasonable person might conclude could potentially influence one’s objectivity in the boardroom in a manner that would have a meaningful impact on an individual’s ability to satisfy requisite fiduciary standards on behalf of shareholders.

 

B-108


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Director Compensation

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR proposals to award cash fees to non-executive directors unless the amounts are excessive relative to other companies in the country or industry.

Vote non-executive director compensation proposals that include both cash and share-based components on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote proposals that bundle compensation for both non-executive and executive directors into a single resolution on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST proposals to introduce retirement benefits for non-executive directors.

Discussion

Proposals seeking shareholder approval for non-executive directors’ fees are not controversial in most countries. RMG generally supports resolutions regarding directors’ fees unless they are excessive relative to fees paid by other companies in the same country or industry. In evaluating such proposals, RMG focuses on the fees paid to each non-executive or, if such detailed information is not available, on the aggregate amount payable to all of the non-executives. Where available, RMG will also take into consideration evidence of past abuses, both by the company and those, if any, characteristic of the market.

Companies in many markets provide their non-executives an option to receive all or a portion of their cash fees in the form of company shares. We approve these measures as the exchange is on a “dollar-for-dollar” basis, that is, as long as a director receives shares having a cash value equal to that of the foregone fees, with the share price used for such calculation being determined on a reasonable date. While there is some dilution associated with such payments, such dilution is minimal, and in any event, increasing directors’ share ownership is likely to align the interests of the directors with those of shareholders.

However, RMG will not support such arrangements if the exchange is not dollar-for-dollar; such exchanges put shareholders at a disadvantage by providing directors the opportunity to receive shares at discount, and the interests of directors who have acquired shares at a discount are likely to be less closely aligned with those of other shareholders. Some companies provide their non-executive directors the opportunity to exchange all or a portion of their cash fees for stock options; we would evaluate such grants in accordance with our stock option guidelines.

As is already common in the United States, companies in some global markets have begun to provide their non-executives with stock options as a separate element of their remuneration. In such countries, proposals seeking approval for the remuneration of non-executive directors cannot be evaluated without detailed information regarding the proposed remuneration, which could include options, and in some cases, discounted options. Remuneration proposals that include option grants must be evaluated in accordance with the guidelines for stock options. Likewise, remuneration proposals that could include option grants — by virtue of their being proposed by a company in a market where option grants to non-employee directors are common — must also be evaluated in accordance with the guidelines for stock options.

Some countries require shareholder approval for the remuneration of executive as well as non-executive directors. Companies in such markets occasionally bundle non-executive and executive remuneration proposals into a single resolution. While RMG generally believes that executive compensation is the purview of the board,

 

B-109


Table of Contents

when proposed executive compensation is gratuitous or otherwise excessive in light of market norms or there is past evidence of abuse, RMG will recommend a vote against such resolutions. In reviewing such proposals, our analysis focuses, among other things, on the amount of the proposed compensation relative to market norms but also relative to the company’s financial performance. For example, absent performance criteria and appropriate limits, it would be inappropriate to approve a resolution entitling an executive to a bonus equal to a substantial portion of a company’s profits.

Retirement benefits for non-executive directors are inappropriate, as they increase the directors’ financial reliance on the company and could call into question the objectivity of their decision-making. In addition, most directors have served as senior executives of other companies, and adequate retirement benefits should be provided through these companies. The only caveat to this policy would be for professional non-executive directors such as those found in the United Kingdom. However, requests for such benefits in the United Kingdom are rare, and the appropriateness of using shareholder funds in this manner is questionable.

 

B-110


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Discharge of Board and Management

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

RMG will generally recommend voting for the discharge of directors, including members of the management board and/or supervisory board, unless there is reliable information about significant and compelling controversies that the board is not fulfilling its fiduciary duties warranted on a case-by-case basis by:

 

   

A lack of oversight or actions by board members which invoke shareholder distrust related to malfeasance or poor supervision, such as operating in private or company interest rather than in shareholder interest

 

   

Any legal issues (e.g. civil/criminal) aiming to hold the board responsible for breach of trust in the past or related to currently alleged action yet to be confirmed (and not only in the fiscal year in question) such as price fixing, insider trading, bribery, fraud, and other illegal actions

 

   

Other egregious governance issues where shareholders will bring legal action against the company or its directors

For markets which do not routinely request discharge resolutions (e.g. common law countries or markets where discharge is not mandatory), analysts may voice concern in other appropriate agenda items, such as approval of the annual accounts or other relevant resolutions, to enable shareholders to express discontent with the board.

Discussion

The annual formal discharge of board and management represents shareholder approval of actions taken during the year. Discharge is a tacit vote of confidence in the company’s management and policies. It does not necessarily eliminate the possibility of future shareholder action, although it does make such action more difficult to pursue. Meeting agendas normally list proposals to discharge both the board and management as one agenda item.

This is a routine item in many countries. Discharge is generally granted unless a shareholder states a specific reason for withholding discharge and plans to undertake legal action. Withholding discharge is a serious matter and is advisable only when a shareholder has concrete evidence of negligence or abuse on the part of the board or management, has plans to take legal action, or has knowledge of other shareholders’ plans to take legal action.

If evidence suggests that one or more board or management members are responsible for problems such as fraud or grave mismanagement, shareholders can withhold discharge from these individuals and pursue further legal action. Poor performance that can be directly linked to flagrant error or neglect on the part of the board or management, or board actions that are detrimental to shareholders’ interests, may also constitute grounds for voting against discharge.

If shareholders approve discharge of the board and management, they will face a greater challenge if they subsequently decide to pursue legal action against these parties. Shareholders would be required to prove that management or the board did not supply correct and complete information regarding the matter in question.

 

B-111


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Director, Officer, and Auditor Indemnification and Liability Provisions

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals seeking indemnification and liability protection for directors and officers on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST proposals to indemnify auditors.

Discussion

The scope of directors’ and officers’ indemnification and liability provisions varies by market. Within reason, RMG seeks to respect the indemnification and liability protections applicable in each market, but some markets allow companies to provide indemnification and liability protection that we deem excessive. In general, RMG believes that officers and directors should only be eligible for indemnification and liability protection if they have acted in good faith on company business and were found innocent of any civil or criminal charges for duties performed on behalf of the company. Providing indemnification and liability protection beyond such levels would effectively absolve officers and directors of their duties to shareholders. RMG recognizes that limiting a company’s ability to provide liability and indemnification protection may limit its ability to attract and retain qualified directors and executives and that indemnification provisions afford directors and officers protection to take risks and maximize shareholder wealth. However, RMG also believes that providing liability and indemnification protection in excess of that outlined above could unfairly prejudice shareholders in holding officers and directors accountable and that the level of protection allowed under our guidelines represents a reasonable compromise.

When evaluating indemnification and liability provisions in more developed markets that enumerate the duty of loyalty and the duty of care, RMG also takes into account the liability and indemnification provisions contained in RMG’s U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines.

Although RMG supports indemnifying directors and officers, RMG opposes providing these protections to auditors. These payments call into question the objectivity of the auditor in carrying out the audit, as the fees paid on its behalf could be greater than the audit fees alone. Eliminating concerns about being sued for carelessness could also lead to a decrease in the quality of the audit. Given the substantial settlements against auditors in recent years for poor audit practices, the cost of such insurance to the company and its shareholders is unwarranted.

 

B-112


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Board Structure

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR proposals to fix board size.

Vote AGAINST the introduction of classified boards and mandatory retirement ages for directors.

Vote AGAINST proposals to alter board structure or size in the context of a fight for control of the company or the board.

Discussion

Resolutions relating to board structures range from fixing the number of directors or establishing a minimum or maximum number of directors to introducing classified boards and director term limits.

Board Size

Proposals to fix board size are common and are routinely approved. Proposals to establish a range of board size are also frequent; a range of two or three open slots relative to the existing board size is reasonable, as it gives the company some flexibility to attract potentially valuable board members during the year. Latitude beyond this range is inappropriate, however, because companies can use this freedom to hinder unwanted influence from potential acquirers or large shareholders.

Adopt Classified Board

RMG prefers that all directors stand for reelection every year. All directors should be accountable to shareholders on an annual basis, as the ability to elect directors is the single most important use of the shareholder franchise.

While classified boards are the norm in most countries, some companies have chosen to place their directors up for annual election. RMG supports initiatives to declassify boards and opposes proposals to classify previously unstaggered boards. Classifying the board makes it more difficult to effect a change of control through a proxy contest; because only a minority of the directors are elected each year, a dissident shareholder would be unable to win control of the board in a single election.

Introduction of Mandatory Age of Retirement

RMG believes that age should not be the sole factor in determining a director’s value to a company. Rather, each director’s performance should be evaluated on the basis of his or her individual contribution and experience.

Altering Board Size

Companies may attempt to increase board size in order to add related or like-minded directors to the board. Conversely, establishing a minimum number of directors could make it easier to remove independent directors from the board. RMG considers these proposals on a case-by-case basis.

All proposals to alter board size during a proxy fight or other possible contests for control should be opposed. Allowing directors to alter the terms of a contest while it is underway is not in shareholders’ interests, as this tactic could be used to thwart a takeover that is in shareholders’ interests.

 

B-113


Table of Contents

Two-Tiered Boards

Companies in many countries have a two-tiered board structure, comprising a supervisory board of non-executive directors and a management board with executive directors. The supervisory board oversees the actions of the management board, while the management board is responsible for the company’s daily operations. At companies with two-tiered boards, shareholders elect members to the supervisory board only; the supervisory board appoints management board members. In Austria, Brazil, the Czech Republic, Germany, Peru, Poland, Portugal, and Russia, two-tiered boards are the norm. Company law in France and Spain also permits them.

 

B-114


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Capital Systems

Companies have one of two main types of capital systems: authorized and conditional. Both systems provide companies with the means to finance business activities, but they are considerably different in structure. Which system a company uses is determined by the economic and legal structure of the market in which it operates.

Authorized Capital System

The authorized capital system sets a limit in a company’s articles on the total number of shares that can be issued by the company’s board. The system allows companies to issue shares from this pre-approved limit, although in many markets shareholder approval must be obtained prior to an issuance. Companies also request shareholder approval for increases in authorization when the amount of shares contained in the articles is inadequate for issuance authorities. RMG reviews proposals for such increases based on the following criteria: the history of issuance requests; the size of the request; the purpose of the issuance (general or specific) associated with the increase in authorization; and the status of preemptive rights (see Share Issuance Requests).

Conditional Capital System

Under the conditional capital system, companies seek authorizations for pools of capital with fixed periods of availability. For example, if a company seeks to establish a pool of capital for general issuance purposes, it requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable piecemeal at the discretion of the board for a fixed period of time. Shares unissued after the fixed time period lapse. This type of authority would be used to carry out a general rights issue or small issuances without preemptive rights.

Requests for a specific issuance authority are tied to a specific transaction or purpose, such as an acquisition or the servicing of convertible securities. Such authorities cannot be used for any purpose other than that specified in the authorization. In this case, a company requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable as needed for the specific purpose requested. This pool of conditional capital also carries a fixed expiration date.

In reviewing these proposals, RMG takes into consideration the existence of pools of capital from previous years. Because most capital authorizations are for several years, new requests may be made on top of the existing pool of capital. While most requests contain a provision to eliminate earlier pools and replace them with the current request, this is not always the case. Thus, if existing pools of capital are being left in place, the aggregate potential dilution amount from all capital should be considered.

 

B-115


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Share Issuance Requests

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

General Issuances:

Vote FOR issuance requests with preemptive rights to a maximum of 100 percent over currently issued capital.

Vote FOR issuance requests without preemptive rights to a maximum of 20 percent of currently issued capital.

Specific Issuances:

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on all requests, with or without preemptive rights.

General Issuances

General issuance requests under both authorized and conditional capital systems allow companies to issue shares to raise funds for general financing purposes. Approval of such requests gives companies sufficient flexibility to carry out ordinary business activities without having to bear the expense of calling shareholder meetings for every issuance.

Issuances can be carried out with or without preemptive rights. Preemptive rights permit shareholders to share proportionately in any new issuances of stock. These rights guarantee existing shareholders the first opportunity to purchase shares of new issuances of stock in the class they own in an amount equal to the percentage of the class they already own. Corporate law in many countries recognizes preemptive rights and requires shareholder approval to waive such rights.

RMG believes that the ability to double share capital through a rights issue (with preemptive rights) provides the company with sufficient financing to meet most contingencies. Rights issues for general capital needs of more than 100 percent of outstanding capital warrant shareholder approval. Issuance authorities of more than 100 percent can lead to excessive cash calls on shareholders, requiring them to provide the funds necessary to maintain their relative positions in the company or to accept substantial dilution.

In some cases, companies may need the ability to raise funds for routine business contingencies without the expense of carrying out a rights issue. Such contingencies could include the servicing of option plans, small acquisitions, or payment for services. When companies make issuance requests without preemptive rights, shareholders suffer dilution as a result of such issuances. Therefore, authorizations should be limited to a fixed number of shares or a percentage of capital at the time of issuance. While conventions regarding this type of authority vary widely among countries, RMG routinely approves issuance requests without preemptive rights for up to 20 percent of a company’s outstanding capital.

Stock exchange listing rules also play a factor in determining the acceptability of share issuance requests. In some markets, companies may ask for the authority to issue all of their authorized but unissued share capital, yet the country’s stock exchange prevents a company from issuing more than ten percent of the company’s share capital in any one year without seeking additional shareholder approval. Another example is global companies that are listed on NASDAQ or the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE). Generally speaking, companies listed on NASDAQ and the NYSE must seek shareholder approval for any issuance of shares or of securities convertible into shares in excess of 20 percent of the company’s outstanding shares at the time of issuance. If stock exchange listing requirements include adequate safeguards with respect to share issuances, RMG will approve the request unless there are specific concerns with the company.

 

B-116


Table of Contents

 

Specific Issuances

Specific issuance requests should be judged on their individual merits. For example, a company may request the issuance of shares for an acquisition in the form of a rights issue to raise funds for a cash payment, or else a company could request an issuance without preemptive rights for use in a share-based acquisition or issuance to a third party. Such a request could be of any size, and RMG recommends approval as long as the proposal is sound. A more routine request would be an authority to issue shares without preemptive rights for issuance as needed upon conversion of convertible securities or to service a share option plan. These shares can only be used for the purpose defined in the resolution.

 

B-117


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Increases in Authorized Capital

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR non-specific proposals to increase authorized capital up to 100 percent over the current authorization unless the increase would leave the company with less than 30 percent of its new authorization outstanding.

Vote FOR specific proposals to increase authorized capital to any amount, unless:

 

   

The specific purpose of the increase (such as a share-based acquisition or merger) does not meet RMG guidelines for the purpose being proposed; or

 

   

The increase would leave the company with less than 30 percent of its new authorization outstanding after adjusting for all proposed issuances.

Vote AGAINST proposals to adopt unlimited capital authorizations.

Discussion

Increases in authorized capital are requested both for general financing flexibility and to provide for a specific purpose. Companies need an adequate buffer of unissued capital in order to take advantage of opportunities during the year, thus they often request increases in authorized capital for no specific purpose other than to retain this flexibility. RMG believes that approving such requests is reasonable.

An increase of 100 percent over the existing authorization gives the company sufficient flexibility in any given year, but requiring that at least 30 percent of the new authorization be outstanding also limits the company’s ability to abuse this privilege. If a company wishes to issue shares for any unforeseen reason during the year that would double (or possibly triple) outstanding share capital, an EGM to seek shareholder approval is justified.

Another important consideration is the status of preemptive rights. Not all countries recognize shareholders’ preemptive rights, and excessive authorizations could lead to substantial dilution for existing shareholders. When preemptive rights are not guaranteed, companies do not need shareholder approval for share issuances as long as the issuance does not result in an increase above the authorized capital limit.

For specific requests, increases in capital up to any size may be justified if the purpose of the new authorization is in shareholders’ interests. Such increases may be needed to fund a variety of corporate activities, thus each proposal must be reviewed on its individual merits. However, the same concerns with dilution exist if the outstanding capital is still less than 30 percent of the new authorization after all issuances take place.

RMG recommends that shareholders vote against proposals seeking to increase authorized capital to an unlimited number of shares. RMG does not believe that companies need unlimited financial flexibility to transact ordinary business because such an arrangement precludes management from periodically consulting shareholders for new capital. Unlimited authorizations may also be used as antitakeover devices, and they have the potential for substantial voting and earnings dilution; they are not in shareholders’ interests.

 

B-118


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reduction of Capital

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR proposals to reduce capital for routine accounting purposes unless the terms are unfavorable to shareholders.

Vote proposals to reduce capital in connection with corporate restructuring on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Proposals to reduce capital can cover a variety of corporate actions, ranging from routine accounting measures to reductions pertaining to a significant corporate restructuring in the face of bankruptcy. In addition, proposals to reduce capital can vary significantly from market to market as a result of local laws and accounting standards. Some examples of capital reduction proposals found overseas include:

Reduction in Stated Capital

One example of this type of proposal asks shareholders to allow the board to reduce the company’s deficit and create a contributed surplus by effecting a reduction in the state capital of the company’s common shares. A company may take this action if its net assets are in danger of falling below the aggregate of its liabilities and its stated capital. Should that situation occur, under some corporate law statutes the company would be prohibited from paying dividends on its shares. RMG usually supports such proposals as they are considered to be routine accounting measures. This type of proposal is seen often in Canada.

Reduction in Connection with Cancellation of Repurchased Shares

A company may also seek a reduction in capital corresponding to the cancellation of shares repurchased in connection with an earlier buyback authorization. The amount of equity that may be cancelled is usually limited to ten percent by national law. This type of proposal is seen most often in Scandinavia, Japan, Spain, and some Latin America markets and is considered a routine accounting measure.

Reduction in Connection with Dividend Payments

If a board determines growth in income to be insufficient to enable the payment of a dividend, it may propose to lower the par value of the company’s shares and pay the difference in par value back to the shareholders, effecting a corresponding reduction in capital. Such reduction is normally effected proportionately against all outstanding capital, and therefore does not involve any material change relative to shareholder value.

Thus, RMG generally recommends that shareholders vote for these proposals, which are most often seen in Switzerland, Spain, and some Latin American markets.

Reduction in Connection with Repayment and Cancellation of Deferred Shares and Preference Shares

Companies may also seek approval for the reduction of share capital pursuant to a repayment and cancellation of deferred shares or preference shares. Deferred shares may be created as bonus shares by a company capitalizing credit from a share premium account pursuant to a reorganization plan, for example, to return excess capital back to shareholders. The company then repurchases the bonus shares in exchange for cash equal to their nominal value and cancels them through a capital reduction. Companies that have preference shares outstanding may also request to cancel and repay these shares which may no longer be required for the carrying out of their financial objectives and may accrue administration costs which have become disproportionate to the

 

B-119


Table of Contents

benefits of maintaining such shares. Preference shares also carry certain rights that restrict the flexibility of conducting certain corporate actions, in particular share repurchases, which is another reason why companies propose to cancel such shares. In either case, RMG supports such reductions as they simplify capital structure and save on administration costs and remove certain restrictions associated with preference shares. This type of proposal is commonly seen in the United Kingdom.

Reduction in Connection with Restructuring

As noted above, some proposals to reduce capital are made in connection with a significant corporate restructuring. RMG generally supports such proposals because opposition could lead to insolvency, which is not in shareholders’ interests. Evaluation of this type of proposal should take a realistic approach to the company’s situation and the future prospects for shareholders.

 

B-120


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Capital Structures

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR resolutions that seek to maintain or convert to a one-share, one-vote capital structure.

Vote AGAINST requests for the creation or continuation of dual-class capital structures or the creation of new or additional supervoting shares.

Discussion

A key decision for any business is determining its capital structure. When timed correctly, sophisticated capital management — finding the right mixes of equity, long-term debt, and short-term financing — can enhance shareholder returns. This process involves coordination of important issues, including dividend policy, tax and interest rates, types of assets, opportunities for growth, ability to finance new projects internally, and cost of obtaining additional capital.

These decisions are best left to a company’s board and senior management, who should be given the latitude to determine the company’s capital structure. However, shareholders should be aware that many financing decisions could have an adverse effect on shareholder returns. For example, additional equity financing may reduce an existing shareholder’s ownership interest and can dilute the value of the investment. Some capital requests can be used as takeover defenses; in response to this situation, company laws establish limits on management’s authority to issue new capital and often require shareholder approval for significant changes in management’s existing authorizations.

RMG supports a one-share, one-vote policy and opposes mechanisms that skew voting rights. Shareholders’ voting rights should accrue in accordance with their equity capital commitment to the company. Dual-class capital structures entrench certain shareholders and management, insulating them from possible takeovers or other external influence or action. The interests of parties with voting control may not be the same as those of shareholders constituting a majority of the company’s capital. Additionally, research and market experience have shown that companies with dual-class capital structures or other antitakeover mechanisms consistently trade at a discount to similar companies without such structures.

When companies with dual class capital structures seek shareholder approval for the creation of new shares, RMG opposes the creation of additional supervoting shares because this perpetuates the dual class structure. If companies are seeking to increase ordinary or subordinate share capital, RMG reviews such requests on a case-by-case basis. If the shares are needed for a specific purpose, RMG recommends approval as long as the proposal meets the issuance guidelines for specific requests. Refusing such requests could cause an immediate loss of shareholder value by not allowing the company to carry out its ordinary business. However, RMG opposes general share creation requests on the grounds that they would perpetuate unequal voting structures. If shareholders routinely approve the creation of ordinary or subordinate voting shares, the company has no incentive to reform its capital structure. By not approving such requests, shareholders can send a signal of dissatisfaction to management.

If a company submits a proposal, which in effect would narrow the gap between the number of votes attached to each share class but not necessarily eliminate the inequality, RMG may still consider supporting the proposal since it entails an improvement compared to the current situation.

 

B-121


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Preferred Stock

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR the creation of a new class of preferred stock or for issuances of preferred stock up to 50 percent of issued capital unless the terms of the preferred stock would adversely affect the rights of existing shareholders.

Vote FOR the creation/issuance of convertible preferred stock as long as the maximum number of common shares that could be issued upon conversion meets RMG’s guidelines on equity issuance requests.

Vote AGAINST the creation of a new class of preference shares that would carry superior voting rights to the common shares.

Vote AGAINST the creation of blank check preferred stock unless the board clearly states that the authorization will not be used to thwart a takeover bid.

Vote proposals to increase blank check preferred authorizations on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Preferred stock is an equity security, but also has certain features that liken it to debt instruments, such as fixed dividend payments, seniority of claims relative to regular common stock, and (in most cases) no voting rights except on matters that affect the seniority of preferred stock as a class. Preferred stock usually ranks senior to a company’s ordinary shares with respect to dividends and the distribution of assets or winding up of the company. Preferred stock can be an effective means of raising capital without increasing debt levels, especially if a company has recently concluded a series of acquisitions.

In determining the acceptability of proposals relating to preferred stock, RMG examines the rights and terms of the proposed shares, including their designation, conditions, restrictions, and limitations. RMG prefers that the terms of preferred stock be set out at the time of the issuance or authorization request. Also important is the company’s justification for issuing or authorizing preferred stock. Whether or not the preferred shares carry voting rights is also considered, especially if the preferred stock will feature superior voting rights to the common shares. While RMG believes that preferred shares are a valid form of financing, we also believe that the creation or issuance of preference shares should be limited to 50 percent of a company’s share capital. RMG will also oppose cases where there has been evidence of management abuse of a past issuance authority.

Voting Preferred Stock

In some markets, preferred stock carries voting rights. Such preference shares may carry voting rights equal to the voting rights of the common shares or may carry multiple voting rights. In such cases, RMG’s guidelines on capital structure are applied. RMG supports a one share, one vote policy and opposes measures that seek to establish dual-class capital structures. However, if a company already has a preference share authorization with different voting rights than the common shares, RMG will approve additional issuances of the preference shares, as long as issuances of these preferred shares are limited and do not adversely affect the rights of common shareholders.

Convertible Preferred Stock

Companies may also seek approval for the creation or issuance of preferred stock that is convertible into common stock. If the shares are convertible into common shares, RMG evaluates the conversion ratio and

 

B-122


Table of Contents

calculates the maximum number of shares that could be issued upon conversion to determine the potential amount of dilution that could result for common shareholders as a result of the proposal. RMG’s equity issuance guidelines are then applied to determine whether the level of dilution is in shareholder’s best interests.

Blank Check Preferred Stock

Companies may also seek shareholder approval for blank check preferred stock, which refers to blanket authorities to issue preferred stock under which the directors are allowed to set the size, terms, and recipient of such shares at the time of issuance. Blank check preferred stock can be used for legitimate corporate purposes such as raising capital or making acquisitions. By not establishing the terms of preferred stock at the time the class of stock is created, companies maintain the flexibility to tailor their preferred stock offerings to prevailing market conditions. However, blank check preferred stock can also be used as an entrenchment device. The ability to issue a block of preferred stock with multiple voting or conversion rights to a friendly investor is a powerful takeover defense.

RMG supports blank check preferred stock proposals as long as the proposal states that the shares will not be issued as a takeover defense. RMG also considers, on a case-by-case basis, proposals to increase authorizations of blank check preferred stock when shareholders have already approved the class of stock and the company has a history of issuing such stock for legitimate financing purposes. Theoretically, companies with authorized blank check preferred stock can use these shares for antitakeover purposes as long as there are a few shares remaining, as they are free to set voting or conversion terms with each issue. Therefore, an increase in authorization may have little effect on the usage of this stock. In cases where a company has issued preferred stock from its authorization for legitimate financing purposes, there is no reason to object to an increase.

 

B-123


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Debt Issuance Requests

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote non-convertible debt issuance requests on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, with or without preemptive rights.

Vote FOR the creation/issuance of convertible debt instruments as long as the maximum number of common shares that could be issued upon conversion meets RMG’s guidelines on equity issuance requests.

Vote FOR proposals to restructure existing debt arrangements unless the terms of the restructuring would adversely affect the rights of shareholders.

Discussion

Debt issuance is a popular financing strategy in world markets. Companies routinely issue bonds directly to shareholders in order to raise funds while enjoying low borrowing costs, although bonds are also often issued without preemptive rights. The issuance of unsecured debt can often include warrants, which are detached at the time of bond issuance. Warrants are usually attached to a debt issuance in order to enhance the marketability of the accompanying fixed income security. Debt instruments are often issued with the right to convert into equity securities. Convertible bonds give holders the choice of becoming shareholders, thereby increasing the shareholder base and liquidity of the company’s stock, or selling their newly converted shares on the open market. In addition, many companies issue debt denominated in currencies other than that of their home market.

When evaluating a debt issuance request, RMG determines the type of debt instrument being issued, the characteristics of the instrument (including whether or not it is convertible into common stock), the intended recipient of the issuance, and the company’s justification for the issuance.

In the case of convertible debt, RMG evaluates the conversion ratio and calculates the maximum number of shares that could be issued upon conversion to determine the potential amount of dilution that could result from the proposal. RMG’s equity issuance guidelines are then applied to determine whether the level of dilution is in shareholders’ best interests.

In the case of non-convertible debt, RMG takes into account the size and purpose of the increase, and the board’s use of past authorizations including examining whether there has been a history of abuse of the authorities. RMG looks at the company’s current financial situation, specifically examining its current debt-to-equity ratio, or gearing level. A high gearing level may incline markets and financial analysts to downgrade the company’s bond rating, increasing its investment risk factor in the process. RMG also considers other factors such as the company’s growth over the past five years relative to earnings or market capitalization, recent corporate events that might affect the company’s bottom line (such as the acquisition of a major competitor or the release of a revolutionary product), and the normal debt levels in the company’s industry and country of origin. Although all of these considerations are factored into RMG’s analysis of debt issuance proposals, RMG generally believes that such financing concerns are best decided by management. RMG will, however, issue vote recommendations against such proposals in cases where there has been evidence of management abuse of an authority, where the proposal is not in line with market practices, or extreme cases where shareholders’ rights could be negatively affected.

Companies may also seek shareholder approval to restructure existing debt arrangements. RMG generally supports restructuring proposals, particularly if the company is in danger of default. However, RMG will oppose restructuring proposals in which common shareholders are being treated unfairly.

 

B-124


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Pledging of Assets for Debt

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to approve the pledging of assets for debt on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

In certain countries, shareholder approval is required when a company needs to secure a debt issuance with its assets. In many cases, this is a routine request and is a formality under the relevant law. When reviewing such proposals, RMG takes into account the terms of the proposed debt issuance and the company’s overall debt level. If both of these factors are acceptable, RMG recommends supporting these requests.

 

B-125


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Increase in Borrowing Powers

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to approve increases in a company’s borrowing powers on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

In some countries, companies are required to seek shareholder approval for increases in their aggregate borrowing power authorities. The aggregate limit on the board’s ability to borrow money is often fixed in a company’s articles, and shareholder approval to change this limit is therefore legally required. RMG believes that a company’s financing needs are best determined by the board, and modest increases in borrowing powers are necessary to allow the company to take advantage of new acquisition opportunities or to complete development and restructuring projects. RMG’s analysis of borrowing power increase requests takes into account management’s stated need for the increase, the size of the increase, and the company’s current gearing level. Large increases in borrowing powers can sometimes result in dangerously high debt-to-equity ratios that could harm shareholder value. If an increase is excessive without sufficient justification and if a company already has exceptionally high gearing compared to its industry, RMG recommends opposing the request.

 

B-126


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Share Repurchase Plans

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Generally vote FOR share repurchase programs/market repurchase authorities, provided that the proposal meets the following parameters:

 

   

Maximum volume: 10 percent for market repurchase within any single authority and 10 percent of outstanding shares to be kept in treasury (“on the shelf”)

 

   

Duration does not exceed 18 months.

RMG will recommend AGAINST any proposal where:

 

   

The repurchase can be used for takeover defense;

 

   

There is clear evidence of abuse;

 

   

There is no safeguard against selective buybacks;

 

   

Pricing provisions and safeguards are deemed to be unreasonable in light of market practice

RMG may support share repurchase plans in excess of 10 percent volume under exceptional circumstances, such as one-off company specific events (e.g. capital restructuring). Such proposals will be assessed CASE-BY-CASE based on merits, which should be clearly disclosed in the annual report, provided that following conditions are met:

 

   

The overall balance of the proposed plan seems to be clearly in shareholders’ interests;

 

   

The plan still respects the 10 percent maximum of shares to be kept in treasury.

Discussion

Proposals regarding share repurchase plans are routine in most countries, and such plans are usually sufficiently regulated by local laws or listing requirements to protect shareholder interests.

RMG looks for the following conditions in share repurchase plans: limitations on a company’s ability to use the plan to repurchase shares from third parties at a premium; limitations on the exercise of the authority to thwart takeover threats; and a requirement that repurchases be made at arm’s length through independent third parties and that selective repurchases require shareholder approval.

Share repurchase programs often involve positive financial consequences to shareholders, as they generally increase the level of earnings per share and bring greater liquidity to the share. Therefore we are generally supportive of share buybacks.

For markets that either generally do not specify the maximum duration of the authority or seek a duration beyond 18 months that is allowable under market specific legislation, RMG will assess the company’s historic practice. If there is evidence that a company has sought shareholder approval for the authority to repurchase shares on an annual basis, RMG will support the proposed authority. In Greece, the legal framework allows share repurchase authorizations to last a maximum of 24 months, although they are typically renewed on a yearly basis. Greek companies typically request shareholders to approve share repurchase schemes in line with provisions in the Company Act. Rarely does a company specify the exact duration of the authorization. Therefore, it is assumed that the duration could be up to 24 months, as foreseen in the legal framework. Around half of Austrian companies restrict share repurchase plans to a limit of 18 months, the majority of Austrian companies either ask for a maximum of 30 months or do not disclose the duration at all.

 

B-127


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reissuance of Shares Repurchased

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR requests to reissue any repurchased shares unless there is clear evidence of abuse of this authority in the past.

Discussion

RMG generally believes that properly timed repurchases of company shares can enhance shareholder value and improve general shareholder returns. With good timing and proper safeguards, the same returns and improvements in shareholder value can be generated through the reissuance of the shares repurchased. In most countries, the text of this general mandate provides sufficient shareholder protection to make this item routine. When reviewing such proposals, RMG takes into account the country’s legal framework for such reissuances and the company’s history of reissuing shares under the authority.

 

B-128


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Capitalization of Reserves for Bonus Issues/Increase In Par Value

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR requests to capitalize reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase par value.

Discussion

Companies routinely carry out bonus issues of shares or increases in par value to existing shareholders, usually through the capitalization of reserves from either the share premium reserve or the retained earnings account. Capitalization of these reserves — transferring them into the share capital account — usually requires shareholder approval. These issuances essentially function as dividends.

When companies increase par value or capitalize reserves and distribute new fully paid shares to shareholders free of charge through a bonus issue, there is no cost to shareholders to maintain their stakes and no risk of dilution. This procedure transfers wealth to shareholders and does not significantly impact share value. The only impact on shareholders is that by increasing the number of shares on issue, the company could increase liquidity, enhance marketability, and ultimately expand its shareholder base.

 

B-129


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reorganizations/Restructurings

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote reorganizations and restructurings on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to approve corporate reorganizations or restructurings range from the routine shuffling of subsidiaries within a group to major rescue programs for ailing companies. RMG usually approves such resolutions unless there are clear conflicts of interest among the various parties, shareholders’ rights are being negatively affected, or certain groups or shareholders appear to be getting a better deal at the expense of general shareholders.

In the case of routine reorganizations of assets or subsidiaries within a group, RMG’s primary focus with the proposed changes is to ensure that shareholder value is being preserved. This includes the effect of the reorganization on the control of group assets, the final ownership structure, the relative voting power of existing shareholders if the share capital is being adjusted, and the expected benefits arising from the changes.

In the case of a distress restructuring of a company or group, shareholders’ options are far more limited; often, they have no choice but to approve the restructuring or lose everything. In such cases, RMG first determines the company’s degree of distress by determining whether or not the company still has a positive net asset value — that is, if realizable assets are greater than liabilities. Although rare, liquidation should be considered an option in these situations.

In most cases, however, the company has a negative asset value, meaning that shareholders would have nothing left after a liquidation. RMG seeks to ensure that the degree of dilution proposed is consistent with the claims of outside parties and is commensurate with the relative commitments of other company stakeholders. Existing shareholders usually must accept the transfer of majority control over the company to outside secured creditors. Ultimately, ownership of a small percentage of something is worth more than majority ownership of nothing.

 

B-130


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Mergers and Acquisitions

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on mergers and acquisitions taking into account the following:

For every M&A analysis, RMG reviews publicly available information as of the date of the report and evaluates the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors including:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, RMG places emphasis on the offer premium, market reaction, and strategic rationale.

 

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction will cause RMG to scrutinize a deal more closely.

 

 

   

Strategic rationale — Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions.

 

 

   

Conflicts of interest — Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? RMG will consider whether any special interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger.

 

 

   

Governance — Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance.

 

Vote AGAINST if the companies do not provide sufficient information upon request to make an informed voting decision.

Discussion

When evaluating the merits of a proposed acquisition, merger, or takeover offer, RMG focuses on the impact of the proposal on shareholder value, both in the immediate and long term. The primary concern is to determine whether or not the proposal is beneficial to shareholders’ existing and future earnings stream and to ensure that the impact on voting rights is not disproportionate to that benefit. Although RMG examines these proposals closely from a corporate governance perspective, a variety of other factors are considered, including the financial terms of the transaction and the strategic rationale for the proposal.

In the case of an acquisition, RMG examines the level of voting or earnings dilution and the logic of the proposed purchase if large share issuances are required. The method of financing is also important, as various methods can result in different valuations than originally perceived. RMG also checks for an independent valuation of the terms, particularly if the target of the acquisition is not a publicly traded entity or asset and precise market valuations are not readily available. RMG also considers the control premium in the transaction. Control premiums on acquisitions vary widely depending on the industry, the time period, and the country. For publicly traded entities or assets, RMG looks at the price of the acquisition relative to the average market price prior to any announcement, as well as the historical price trends for 60 days prior. For non-publicly traded entities or assets, an independent financial evaluation becomes even more important.

 

B-131


Table of Contents

In the case of mergers, RMG examines whether or not the merger makes commercial or strategic sense for the company. RMG also considers the method of effecting the merger and the ultimate impact on shareholders of the proposed financial and corporate governance structure. While historical relative valuations based on market prices are useful in the financial evaluation process, the often-complicated financial details of such proposals make an independent fairness opinion of extreme importance. The proposed board structure, share capital structure, relative share ownership, and any takeover defenses of the new company are all important factors for consideration in this evaluation process.

Obviously, levels of disclosure regarding merger and acquisition proposals will vary greatly from market to market. In more developed markets, shareholders are often provided with detailed financial and governance information as well as an independent fairness opinion and in some cases, a formal valuation report. When evaluating proposals in these markets, RMG relies primarily on the documents and information provided by the company and its advisors. However, in many emerging markets, detailed information regarding mergers and acquisitions can be scarce. In these markets, RMG must rely more heavily on secondary sources, including local shareholder associations, market reaction to the proposed transaction, and news reports.

If the details of a given proposal are unclear or not available and a fairness opinion (in markets where they are regularly provided) is also not available, RMG recommends voting against the proposal. If a company is uncooperative in providing information about the proposal or is evasive when responding to questions, RMG recommends voting against the item in question.

 

B-132


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Mandatory Takeover Bid Waivers

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote proposals to waive mandatory takeover bid requirements on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Many countries impose a bid threshold that forces any shareholder whose stake exceeds the limit to tender a public bid to all the other owners to purchase the remaining shares. The thresholds are imposed either by national law, stock exchange rules, or a company’s articles of association. This mandatory takeover bid rule prohibits a shareholder from owning a large stake in the company and having a dominating voice in the decision-making without being required to purchase the remainder of the shares. Without such a requirement, the other shareholders, although potentially holding a substantial percentage of the company’s shares, would be left with relatively little say in decisions. Mandatory bid requirements also seek to prevent “creeping acquisitions” and to ensure that shareholders, other than the controlling shareholder, receive a control premium when control of the company shifts to the large shareholder.

RMG opposes proposals to exempt a large shareholder from the obligation to bid. The requirement that a takeover bid should be launched when a substantial amount of shares have been acquired prevents the entrenchment of the controlling shareholder and protects minority owners.

RMG does make an exception to the mandatory takeover bid rule when the event prompting the takeover bid is a repurchase by the company of its own shares. When a company repurchases its own shares, the relative stake of a large shareholder increases even though the number of shares held by the large shareholder has not changed. In certain markets, notably the United Kingdom and Ireland, the mandatory bid rules require a large shareholder to make a takeover bid if its stake in the company is increased on a relative basis as a result of a share repurchase by the company. Companies in these markets may seek a waiver from the takeover bid requirement applicable to their large shareholder. Under certain circumstances, RMG will support such a waiver, namely, if the share repurchase would not push the large shareholder’s stake in the company above 50 percent.

 

B-133


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Reincorporation Proposals

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote reincorporation proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Reincorporation proposals are most commonly seen in Canada, where companies may register under one of the provincial business statutes. However, companies in other countries may also seek shareholder approval to reincorporate in a U.S. state or another country. Many companies, including U.S. companies, choose to reincorporate in places such as Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, or the British Virgin Islands for tax purposes.

When examining a reincorporation proposal, RMG first examines the reasons for the move. Sometimes a reincorporation proposal is part of a restructuring effort or merger agreement that contributes significantly to a company’s growth, financial health, and competitive position more than the anticipated negative consequences of incorporating in another province or country. Some reincorporations allow firms to realize lower taxes or incorporation fees. In addition, there may be advantages to incorporating in the province in which the company conducts the bulk of its business.

Companies often adopt a new charter or bylaws with increased protection for management upon reincorporation. For instance, many reincorporation proposals are bundled with the ratification of a new charter that increases the company’s capital stock or imposes a classified board. When such changes to the charter include the addition of negative corporate governance provisions, the impact of these new provisions on shareholders must be balanced against the anticipated benefits of the reincorporation.

RMG believes that reincorporations to countries, states, or provinces with less stringent disclosure requirements or corporate governance provisions are often management attempts to lessen accountability to shareholders. In such cases, RMG recommends voting against the proposal. The expenses involved in a change of domicile relating to legal and administrative fees, plus the greater entrenchment such a reincorporation could provide management, would likely harm shareholders’ interests. In cases where companies propose to move to a more protective province or country and supply reasonable financial reasons for doing so, the benefits of the reincorporation must be weighed against the costs of possible management entrenchment.

 

B-134


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Expansion of Business Activities

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote FOR resolutions to expand business activities unless the new business takes the company into risky areas.

Discussion

Companies are usually required by law to include in their articles of association or memorandum of association specific business purposes in the form of an objects clause. Because most countries require shareholder approval before articles can be amended, any change to the company’s objects clause requires shareholder approval. Countries often seek shareholder approval to amend the objects clause to expand business lines.

Expanding business lines is a decision usually best left to management, but there are some instances where RMG withholds support for such changes. If a company has performed poorly for several years and seeks business expansion into a risky enterprise, RMG would require further clarification from management regarding the purpose of the expansion. If the company does not provide a satisfactory business plan, RMG recommends that shareholders vote against the proposal.

 

B-135


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Related-Party Transactions

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote related-party transactions on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Shareholders are often asked to approve commercial transactions between related parties. A transaction between a parent company and its subsidiary, or a company’s dealings with entities that employ the company’s directors, are usually classified as related-party transactions and are subject to company law or stock exchange listing requirements that mandate shareholder approval. Shareholder approval of these transactions is meant to protect shareholders against insider trading abuses.

In most cases, both the rationale and terms of such transactions are reasonable. RMG looks for evidence of an evaluation of the transaction by an independent body, but this is not always available. Unless the agreement requests a strategic move outside the company’s charter or contains unfavorable terms, RMG recommends that shareholders support the proposal.

 

B-136


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Compensation Plans

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote compensation plans on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Disclosure on compensation in many markets is still not as extensive as U.S.-style disclosure. However, compensation plans are becoming more common on meeting agendas of non-U.S. companies, and the structures of these plans are of vital interest to shareholders. When given the opportunity to review these structures, RMG supports plans that motivate participants to focus on long-term shareholder value and returns, encourage employee stock ownership, and more closely align employee interests with those of shareholders.

For many years, RMG has employed a complex compensation model methodology for evaluating compensation proposals in the United States and Canada, but this has only been possible because of the extensive disclosure provided in these markets’ proxy circulars. This degree of disclosure is a reflection of strict regulatory requirements, investor concern and activity, and corporate governance sophistication.

Beyond the problems presented by limited disclosure, local conditions and traditions in particular countries also hinder the creation of a comprehensive compensation evaluation procedure. Standard market practice in one country may be illegal activity in another. Some countries establish numerical limits on the number of shares available under their plans, while others have percentage limits that apply over a specific length of time. Holding all global companies to the strict standards of the United States, for example, could result in recommendations against almost every compensation plan in many countries. Conversely, making too many allowances for local practices may only encourage poor governance standards over the long term.

RMG reviews three main types of compensation plans: stock option plans, incentive plans, and share purchase plans. Also included in this section are grants outside of plans. RMG analyzes plans by calculating the potential dilution under a company’s share plans and by analyzing plan features.

Stock Option Plans

Stock option plans grant participants an option to buy company shares at a set price (the exercise price). Shares are usually granted at market prices and may be exercised when the company’s share price reaches the exercise price. Participants may then purchase the promised shares at the strike price and may later sell the shares after their purchase (or after a defined holding period when the shares may not be sold).

When evaluating stock option plans, RMG’s first hurdle is obtaining information regarding the key terms of the plan. Ideally, we would like to see the full text of the plan, or a summary of the plan’s key terms, with information on the plan’s dilution, exercise price/presence of discounts, administration and participation, types of awards used, vesting provisions, and performance criteria. However, in many markets, especially where companies are only beginning to introduce stock-based compensation, information on key plan terms can be quite limited. RMG generally supports efforts to more closely align executive pay with shareholder interests, and generally encourages companies to improve their compensation disclosure practices. However, until disclosure standards improve in these markets, RMG believes that it would be counterproductive to oppose all plans in a given country on this basis. Still, some basic parameters are necessary in order for RMG to consider supporting a compensation plan. At a minimum, RMG requires information on the maximum potential dilution of a plan and information concerning the exercise price. If a plan meets our guidelines on these two points, RMG will support the plan. For markets where certain plan information is regularly disclosed, and a company has failed to provide this information to shareholders, RMG will vote against the plan on the basis of substandard disclosure.

 

B-137


Table of Contents

 

Among the criteria that RMG examines in evaluating stock option plans are the following, generally organized from criteria of greater importance to criteria of lesser importance:

Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options Under the Plan

The maximum number of shares RMG approves under a plan depends on the classification of a company’s stage of development as growth or mature. Growth companies are usually smaller, in new industries requiring significant research and development, and have restricted cash flows. A company in an established industry but expanding rapidly, or a mature company that is experiencing an extended period of rapid expansion, may also be classified as growth. Mature companies are characterized by stable sales and revenue growth, production efficiencies resulting from volume gains, and strong cash flow resulting from developed products in the payoff stage.

For mature companies, shares available under stock option plans should be no more than 5 percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans. For growth companies, shares available should be no more than 10 percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans. However, RMG will support plans at mature companies with dilution levels of up to 10 percent if the plan includes other positive features, such as challenging performance criteria or premium-priced options. These features partially offset dilution concerns, as their inclusion reduces the likelihood that options will become exercisable unless there is a clear improvement in shareholder value.

For all companies, an absolute number of shares fixed at the time of approval is ideal, but many countries do not include such a limit. In these cases, revolving limits (a certain percentage of issued shares at any one time) of 5 percent or 10 percent are common. The practice of setting a percentage of shares issuable over a certain number of years before or after the plan is adopted appears to be a compromise between these first two methods. RMG prefers plans where the limits are sufficiently spread out, e.g., 5 percent in five years, 10 percent in ten years. Revolving limits of 10 percent in ten years should also include “flow-rate” restrictions that further limit the plan’s dilution, such as a cap of “3 percent in three years,” “2.5 percent in five years,” or “1 percent in one year.”

Exercise Price

RMG prefers that options be priced at not less than 100 percent of the shares’ fair market value on the date of grant. Usually this is taken as the closing price of the company’s shares on the day prior to the date of grant. Some countries determine fair market value as an average of the trading price for the five days prior to the date of grant. This is a common and acceptable practice. Some emerging market countries use a 30-day average or longer to determine fair market value; these resolutions must be reviewed on a case-by-case basis, although provisions of longer than 30 days increase the possibility of discounted options.

Discounted Options, Restricted Stock, and Stock Grants

Many countries allow for options to be granted at a discount to market prices. RMG evaluates restricted stock, which is essentially a deeply discounted option often with mandatory vesting provisions, in the same manner as a discounted option. Restricted stock, which is generally offered at a 100-percent discount and vests in three to five years, is most often seen in the United States, but it is becoming increasingly popular in other jurisdictions. Stock grants are another type of discounted award in which company shares may be granted outright to recipients with no payment required for the receipt of shares. In the absence of performance criteria (see below), RMG opposes grants of discounted options, including restricted stock. Absent performance criteria or vesting provisions, holders of discounted options or restricted stock have an incentive to cash in their grants for an immediate return rather than hold on to their options for future gains, thereby reducing or eliminating the incentive value of such awards. RMG generally opposes stock grants as their incentive value is dubious.

 

B-138


Table of Contents

 

In very rare cases, RMG may consider supporting a plan that includes discounted options, including restricted stock, if the company has attached challenging performance criteria to the options, including price hurdles. Performance-based vesting provisions require tangible improvements in the company’s financial performance or share price before the discounted options or restricted shares can be exercised. Performance criteria are evaluated by reference to both the company’s country of incorporation and industry. Recipients of discounted options and restricted shares are required to tender less consideration, if any, to exercise their awards than recipients of market-priced options are required to tender; as a result, the former type of awards are more costly to shareholders from an economic perspective. However, the higher performance threshold imposed by suitably challenging performance criteria may mitigate the higher economic costs.

In general, RMG does not believe that vesting provisions, however stringent, sufficiently mitigate the excessive cost of discounted awards, but with respect to the use of restricted stock in U.S.-style stock option plans seen in global markets, RMG recognizes that restricted stock is a common feature of these plans, that often these awards represent only a small portion (usually significantly below 1 percent) of a company’s outstanding share capital, and that performance criteria are not common in U.S.-style plans. As a result, RMG believes that it would be counterproductive to oppose all such plans solely on the inclusion of restricted stock. However, RMG would only approve of plans that set out strict limits on such grants, include stringent vesting provisions, sufficiently challenging performance criteria, and that meet our guidelines in all other aspects.

Plan Administration

RMG opposes allowing the administering committee to grant options to itself due to the potential for abuse and conflicts of interest. Administration of plans should be in the hands of directors who are unable to participate in the plan. Plans administered by the full board should not allow voting by executive directors; plans administered by remuneration committees should be composed entirely of independent directors. Plans that allow non-executive directors to participate should not give them any discretion on individual grants; instead, an automatic system of grants should be introduced with fixed annual grants at market prices on a fixed date. Alternatively, RMG approves of separate non-executive director option plans with independent administration if the number of shares reserved for such plans is limited. Shares reserved for director plans, when combined with shares reserved for all of the company’s stock option plans should not exceed RMG’s aggregate dilution limits. In addition, shares reserved over the life of such a plan should not exceed 1 percent of a company’s outstanding share capital for mature companies and 1.6 percent for growth-oriented companies for a five-year plan. Shares reserved for non-executive director option grants in any one year should not exceed 0.2 percent for mature companies and 0.3 percent for growth companies.

Eligibility and Participation

RMG prefers separate plans for employees, directors, and non-executive directors, but most plans include all or some combination of these categories of participants. Other global plans distinguish between full-time and part-time employees or establish a set length of service to the company (usually one year) before options may be granted. Most plans allow the administrating committee to select plan participants.

Performance Criteria and Vesting Provisions

Performance criteria and vesting provisions are important considerations when evaluating a compensation plan, and the existence of long vesting provisions and realistic performance criteria may compensate for minor shortcomings in a plan. If a plan falls just beyond one of the above guidelines but has both performance criteria and vesting provisions, support may be justified. RMG prefers a minimum three-year vesting period. The ultimate goal of share option plans is to tie executive and employee remuneration to company performance and to give key employees and executives incentive to stay with the firm. We favor the inclusion of performance targets and graduated vesting schedules because awards that are contingent upon sustained and measurable improvements are more likely to fulfill their purpose of truly providing incentive. However, if a plan meets all

 

B-139


Table of Contents

other aspects of RMG’s guidelines, these two criteria are not mandatory, unless the inclusion of such provisions are standard in the company’s country of incorporation and a company has failed to include them.

Other Features Specific to Option Plans

Issue Terms

Some countries require optionees to pay a nominal fee (often equivalent to $0.01) for every option received. This is common and acceptable, although many companies that once enforced this provision are now deleting it from the rules of their plans.

Option Repricing

Some plans include specific provisions allowing for the repricing of options at the board’s discretion. RMG opposes plans that include option repricing when the exercise price is reduced in response to a dropping share price. Repricing outstanding options reduces the incentive that options provide to raise the share price for shareholders.

Financial Assistance

Some plans offer participants loans to pay the full exercise price on their options. If loans are part of a company’s option plan, RMG prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. RMG also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessary warrant a recommendation against an option plan, but they are taken into consideration in RMG’s analysis of the plan.

Plans for International Employees

Many overseas companies introduce separate plans or delegate a special section of their option plan to deal with tax considerations raised by having a large number of employees working in other countries. Many of these plans contain provisions that deal directly with particular U.S. tax code provisions on stock options. RMG applies the same criteria to these plans as to country-specific plans.

Stock Appreciation Rights

Stock appreciation rights (SARs) allow participants to receive the difference between the exercise price and the market price at the date of exercise. Many companies use SARs in lieu of regular options. While SARs do not result in the dilution associated with large option exercises, there is little difference between a SAR and a regular option from a shareholder perspective because the financial cost to the company is the same. However, SARs do not encourage stock ownership by participants because they involve no purchase or sale of company stock. RMG reviews SARs in the context of the option plan under which they are issued.

Phantom Stock Option Plans

Phantom stock options offer participants cash bonuses based on the increase in share price during a set period of time. Phantom plans are distinct from SARs in that they often form their own separate plan. Some companies will create a phantom stock option plan to award employees who reside in countries that do not allow stock-based compensation. Participants are designated a set number of hypothetical (phantom) shares, on which the award is based. While RMG prefers compensation plans that encourage employee ownership, SARs and phantom options are an effective way to provide incentive.

 

B-140


Table of Contents

 

Superoptions

Superoptions exceed the limits in a particular country for the value of options granted to any one individual, although they are usually tied to significantly more restrictive vesting provisions and performance criteria. U.K. superoptions, for example, exceed the Association of British Insurers’ recommended limit that options represent no more than one times a participant’s salary in any year, yet the stricter performance criteria and longer vesting periods usually mitigate excessive grants. Additionally, dilution resulting from superoptions has historically been fairly moderate. Superoptions appear most often in advanced markets with developed stock option plans.

Dividends Under Option and Dividend Equivalent Payment Provisions

Most holders of stock options do not receive dividend payments. However, some option plans allow participants to receive dividends or dividend equivalent payments prior to the exercise of options. RMG believes that any economic benefit derived from option plans should occur at the time of exercise.

Using Repurchased Shares in Share Compensation Plans

In many countries, companies purchase shares on the market for use in their compensation plans. In some cases, using repurchased shares is more efficient than issuing new shares to participants on exercise. RMG also recognizes the benefits to existing shareholders when repurchased shares are used to fund option grants, as dilution to their interests is minimized. However, although there is no cost to shareholders in terms of dilution of their voting interests (“voting dilution”), buybacks still represent a real cost to the company and shareholders (“economic dilution”). As a result, if a company wants to use repurchased shares in its compensation plans, RMG will include repurchased shares in its dilution calculation and apply the same dilution thresholds as for newly issued shares (see above under “Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options under the Plan”) .

RMG recommends that shareholders support a plan if it includes a specified limit on the total number of shares that could be used and if repurchased shares would count toward that limit, as long as it meets all other guidelines. However, RMG looks for an additional limitation, either an aggregate numerical limit, a percentage limit, or limitations on individual awards, when repurchased shares do not count toward the plan’s limit on newly issued shares, but rather operate as an additional pool of shares.

Incentive Plans

Share incentive plans tie key employees’ compensation more directly to company performance. Though most popular in the United Kingdom, incentive plans are becoming increasingly popular across the globe. Incentive plans provide participants with free grants of company shares (or, less frequently, cash grants) in proportion with prearranged performance criteria-often earnings per share measured against inflation or total shareholder return. These indicators are frequently compared with those of other firms in the company’s industry or stock market index, creating a benchmark and a further determinant of the number of shares granted to a particular participant. Proponents of incentive plans note that they offer shareholders the potential for less dilution and that they more directly encourage participants to focus on long-term company performance through strict performance criteria tied to more than just share price movements.

Most incentive plans are organized with strict vesting provisions, where participants may not receive the share awards until after a period of three years or more. Many plans also grant a percentage of the total amount reserved for each participant on a sliding scale measured against performance criteria. Performance criteria targets that have been satisfied only to a certain point may represent disbursement of 25 percent of the shares or cash to a participant, while 100-percent satisfaction may represent the full allotment of the grant. From a shareholder perspective, this graduated system of performance criteria is a major advance.

Evaluation of incentive plans is similar to that of option plans in that acceptable dilution and impartial administration and eligibility remain key factors for a positive recommendation. Insufficient performance criteria or abbreviated vesting provisions are deciding factors as well.

 

B-141


Table of Contents

 

Employee Stock Purchase Plans and Savings-Related Share Option Schemes

Employee stock purchase plans and savings-related share option schemes (together, ESPPs) provide employees an opportunity to purchase stock in their company, often at a discount to market prices. Plans may operate via monthly deductions from employees’ paychecks, gathered and held for safekeeping by a trust or bank, and used to purchase company stock on behalf of the employee. ESPPs can lead to greater commitment from employees, provide performance incentives, and provide all employees the opportunity to share in the company’s growth.

ESPPs differ from stock option plans in that in an ESPP, all eligible participants have the option to participate in the plan and may choose how much they wish to contribute to the plan, whereas in a stock option plan, the administering committee chooses who actually participates in the plan, that is, receives options under the plan. RMG recommends approval for many of these plans because they encourage wide share ownership in the company among employees. When analyzing ESPPs for global companies, RMG considers the following factors:

Eligibility

This is an important factor when considering ESPPs proposed by global companies. For a plan to qualify as an ESPP, all full-time employees who have been with the company for a reasonable amount of time (some plans also allow for participation by part-time employees) must be eligible to participate in the plan, and more important, eligible participants must have the ability to determine whether they will participate and to what extent they will participate, subject to certain limits, as discussed below.

Dilution

Many markets, such as the United States, Canada, Ireland, and certain tax haven markets, differentiate between shares reserved for ESPPs and shares reserved for stock option plans. In these markets it is our practice to have separate dilution limits (a) for shares reserved for ESPPs, and (b) shares reserved for stock option plans. Other markets, notably the United Kingdom, do not reserve separate pools of shares for ESPPs and option plans, therefore we cannot make such distinctions.

For those markets that reserve a separate pool of shares for ESPPs, RMG policy is to exclude such shares from our dilution calculations for stock option plans. However, RMG policy provides that no more than 10 percent of a company’s shares may be reserved for ESPPs at any given time, with such 10 percent being over and above the company’s limit (either 5 or 10 percent) reserved for option plans, as long as discounts do not exceed 15 percent. Accordingly, a company could have up to 10 percent of its shares reserved for option plans and 10 percent of its shares reserved for ESPPs at any given time. If market practice dictates a larger discount under the ESPPs, the allowable dilution will be adjusted downward proportionately. For example, if a company is allowed to offer discounts of 30 percent, the allowable dilution will be 5 percent. Allowable dilution on discounts between 15 percent and 30 percent will be determined on a pro rata basis. Alternatively, RMG would consider a higher dilution limit for ESPPs if the company in question sufficiently limited dilution under its option plans.

For those markets that reserve a common pool of shares for ESPPs and stock option plans, RMG policy is to evaluate the dilution under the common pool of shares in accordance with the dilution limitations applicable to stock option plans.

Offering Period and Offering Price

The offering period, also known as the purchase period, is the time period over which a participant’s contributions are accumulated for the purchase of shares under the plan. The offering price is the company’s share price taken on a specific date, less the applicable discount, at which a participant’s accumulated payroll deductions are used to purchase shares. Both the offering period and the offering price are country- and

 

B-142


Table of Contents

plan-specific. For example, ESPPs that are intended to comply with Section 423 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code (Section 423 Plans) and therefore qualify for favorable tax treatment may not have an offering period in excess of 27 months. Section 423 Plans, however, almost always provide for an “either/or” offering price, which provides participants the right to purchase shares at the lesser of the fair market value of that company’s shares, less the applicable discount, as of either the first or last day of the offering period. In contrast, plans in the United Kingdom and Ireland generally have a three-, five-, or even seven-year offering period, and the offering price is the fair market value on the date an employee commences participation in the plan.

RMG’s assessment of a plan takes into account the length of the offering period and the date on which the offering price is determined. If the plan has an “either/or” feature, a shorter offering period is in the interests of shareholders because such provisions reduce the market risk associated with the plan. The maximum offering period for plans with such a feature is 27 months. In contrast, if the offering price is based on the price of the company’s shares on the date plan participation commences, then a longer offering period is generally in the interests of shareholders, as it should more effectively focus the efforts of plan participants on increasing shareholder value. In these cases, the minimum offering period is three years.

Discounts

These are generally country-specific, e.g. the maximum discount under a Section 423 Plan is 15 percent. In the United Kingdom the maximum discount is 20 percent, and in Ireland it is 25 percent. The amount of the discount is often obscured because some plans do not provide for a discount per se, but rather provide that participants will receive matching shares. This practice is common in Canada. For instance, a plan may stipulate that for every two shares a participant purchases under a plan, the company will provide one “matching share” to the participant; in effect the participant receives three shares for the price of two, which is mathematically equivalent to a 33-percent discount. If a plan employs matching shares, the analyst must simply calculate the imputed discount using the maximum match.

In reviewing discounts, RMG takes into consideration the offering period and offering price. Because plans with “either/or” provisions reduce the market risk associated with plan purchases, we believe the maximum discount available under such plans should be 15 percent. However, RMG guidelines allow for greater discounts, up to 25 percent, for plans in which the offering price is based on the company’s share price on the date participation commences.

Limits on the Number or Value of Shares Purchasable (Participation Limits)

ESPPs must specify a limit on the number or value of shares each participant is eligible to purchase, for Section 423 Plans it is US$25,000 per year, in the United Kingdom and Ireland it is GBP 3,000 and IRP 3,000, respectively. Because the shares are discounted, there must be some limit on the ability of eligible employees to participate to prevent excessive dilution. This also limits the ability of executives to buy, via the plan, large amounts of discounted shares. Ideally, there should be a plan feature prohibiting employees who are large shareholders (5 percent in Section 423 Plans) from participating.

Loan Terms

Some plans offer participants loans to pay for the shares. If loans are part of a share purchase plan, RMG prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. RMG also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessarily warrant a recommendation against a share purchase plan, but they are taken into consideration in RMG’s analysis of the plan.

 

B-143


Table of Contents

 

Grants Outside of Plans

Resolutions asking shareholders to approve specific grants of shares or cash outside of established plans are problematic. Some companies prefer not to adopt formal share plans, instead asking shareholders to approve yearly grants to specific employees. RMG prefers that companies make such grants in the context of an established plan.

RMG’s primary concern with grants outside of plans is the level of dilution they afford. The number of shares issued as part of the grants, when combined with the number of shares reserved for the company’s other share plans, must fall within acceptable dilution limits. Vesting provisions and performance criteria are also important and are evaluated on the same basis as if the grants were part of a formal plan.

 

B-144


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Antitakeover Mechanisms

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote AGAINST all antitakeover proposals unless they are structured in such a way that they give shareholders the ultimate decision on any proposal or offer.

Discussion

Common antitakeover mechanisms include staggered boards, supervoting shares, poison pills, unlimited authorized capital authorizations (including blank check preferred stock), and golden shares. Some of these restrictions are aimed solely at limiting share ownership by foreign or unwanted minority shareholders, and others are designed to preclude an unwanted takeover of the target company by any party. RMG opposes all forms of such mechanisms, as they limit shareholder value by eliminating the takeover or control premium for the company. As owners of the company, shareholders should be given the opportunity to decide on the merits of takeover offers.

Golden Shares

Recently privatized companies around the world often include in their share structure a golden share held by their respective governments. These shares often carry special voting rights or the power of automatic veto over specific proposals. Golden shares are most common among former state-owned companies or politically sensitive industries such as utilities, railways, and airlines. While the introduction of golden shares is not a desirable governance practice, RMG recognizes the political importance certain companies hold for governments and treats the introduction or amendment of government shares on a case-by-case basis.

Supermajority Vote Requirements

Supermajority vote requirements violate the principle that a simple majority of voting shares should be all that is necessary to effect change regarding a company and its corporate governance provisions. Requiring more than this may permit management to entrench themselves by blocking provisions that are in the best interest of shareholders. However, in many world markets, supermajority vote requirements for special resolutions or EGMs are the norm, either two-thirds or three-fourths of shares voting at the meeting (either in person or by proxy). When reviewing proposals to introduce supermajority vote requirements, RMG takes into account market norms, the company’s reasons for the change, and the company’s ownership structure.

 

B-145


Table of Contents

 

2010 International Voting-Policy Manual

Shareholder Proposals

 

RMG General Recommendation & Policy

Vote all shareholder proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote FOR proposals that would improve the company’s corporate governance or business profile at a reasonable cost.

Vote AGAINST proposals that limit the company’s business activities or capabilities or result in significant costs being incurred with little or no benefit.

Discussion

RMG reviews all shareholder proposals to ascertain whether the proposal is beneficial or detrimental to shareholder value. Most resolutions fall into three basic categories: corporate governance, social, and environmental. While shareholder proposals in most countries are not as prevalent as they are in the United States, they are becoming more common, and standards for reviewing the various types of proposals are necessary.

Corporate Governance Proposals

Corporate governance-related proposals must be evaluated carefully because any changes can dramatically affect shareholder value. Support for such proposals must be measured against the likely impact that approval would have on the company’s operations. If a measure would improve disclosure of company activities in non-strategic areas and at minimal costs, RMG supports the proposal. If a proposal seeks to improve the company’s corporate governance structure, such as adopting board committees, eliminating staggered board structures, or canceling antitakeover instruments, approval is also warranted. However, if acceptance of a proposal is likely to lead to a disruption in board or management operations and to cause the company to incur significant costs without clear benefit, RMG recommends opposing the proposal.

Social and Environmental Proposals

In evaluating social and environmental proposals, RMG first determines whether or not the issue in question should be addressed on a company-specific basis. Many social and environmental issues are beyond the scope of any one company and are more properly the province of government and broader regulatory action. If this is the case, RMG recommends voting against the proposal.

Most proposals of this type require shareholders to apply subjective criteria in making their voting decision. While broader issues are of concern to everyone, institutional shareholders acting as representatives of their beneficiaries are required to consider only the ultimate interests of their direct beneficiaries. Relating the interests of their beneficiaries to the greater good can be a difficult process and a matter for individual determination. For this reason, RMG focuses on the financial aspects of social and environmental proposals. If a proposal would have a negative impact on the company’s financial position or adversely affect important operations, RMG recommends opposing the resolution. Conversely, if a proposal would have a clear and beneficial impact on the company’s finances or operations, RMG recommends supporting the proposal.

 

B-146


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 

2010 Taft-Hartley U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines

January 2010

 

 

 

Copyright © 2010 by RiskMetrics Group.

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.

Risk Management  |  RiskMetrics Labs  |  ISS Governance Services  |  Financial Research & Analysis

www.riskmetrics.com


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

  

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

     B-151   

DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

     B-151   

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

     B-152   

Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

     B-153   

Independent Directors

     B-154   

Non-Independent Chairman

     B-154   

Excessive Directorships

     B-155   

Performance/Governance Evaluation for Directors

     B-155   

Director Diversity

     B-156   

Stock Ownership Requirements

     B-157   

Classified Boards — Annual Elections

     B-157   

Board and Committee Size

     B-157   

Limit Term of Office

     B-158   

Cumulative Voting

     B-158   

Failure to Act on Shareholder Proposals Receiving Majority Support

     B-159   

Votes Against or Withholds from Directors for Shareholder Rights Plan (i.e. Poison Pills)

     B-159   

Shareholder Access to the Proxy (“Open Access”)

     B-160   

Majority Threshold Voting Requirement for Director Elections

     B-160   

Establish An Office of the Board

     B-161   

Director and Officer Indemnification ~ Liability Protection

     B-161   

Indemnification

     B-161   

COMPENSATION

     B-161   

Stock Option Plans

     B-163   

Methodology for Analyzing Pay Plans

     B-163   

Voting Power Dilution (VPD) Calculation

     B-164   

Fair Market Value, Dilution and Repricing

     B-164   

Burn Rate

     B-165   

Executive Concentration Ratio

     B-165   

Principle of Pay-For-Performance

     B-165   

Evergreen Provisions

     B-165   

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

     B-165   

Problematic Compensation Practices and Compensation Committee Performance

     B-166   

Restricted Stock

     B-168   

Executive Holding Periods

     B-168   

Performance-Based Options

     B-168   

Options Backdating

     B-169   

Pension Plan Income Accounting

     B-169   

Shareholder Proposals to Limit Executive and Director Pay

     B-169   

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Shareholder Proposals

     B-169   

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Management Proposals

     B-169   

Compensation Consultants — Disclosure of Board or Company’s Utilization

     B-170   

Golden and Tin Parachutes

     B-170   

Executive Perks and Retirement/Death Benefits

     B-170   

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

     B-171   

OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals

     B-171   

Amendments to Add Performance-Based Goals

     B-171   

Amendments to Increase Shares and Retain Tax Deductions Under OBRA

     B-171   

Approval of Cash or Cash-and-Stock Bonus Plans

     B-171   

 

B-148


Table of Contents

AUDITORS

     B-172   

Auditor Independence

     B-172   

Auditor Ratification

     B-172   

Auditor Rotation

     B-173   

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

     B-173   

Disclosures Under Section 404 of Sarbanes-Oxley Act

     B-174   

Adverse Opinions

     B-174   

TAKEOVER DEFENSES

     B-175   

Poison Pills

     B-175   

Greenmail

     B-176   

Shareholder Ability to Remove Directors

     B-176   

Shareholder Ability to Alter the Size of the Board

     B-176   

SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS

     B-176   

Confidential Voting

     B-176   

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

     B-177   

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

     B-177   

Unequal Voting Rights

     B-177   

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Amend the Charter or Bylaws

     B-177   

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Approve Mergers

     B-178   

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

     B-178   

Bundled Proposals

     B-178   

MERGERS & ACQUISITIONS/CORPORATE RESTRUCTURINGS

     B-179   

Fair Price Provisions

     B-179   

Corporate Restructuring

     B-180   

Appraisal Rights

     B-180   

Spin-offs

     B-180   

Asset Sales

     B-180   

Liquidations

     B-180   

Going Private Transactions (LBOs, Minority Squeezeouts)

     B-180   

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

     B-180   

CAPITAL STRUCTURE

     B-182   

Common Stock Authorization

     B-182   

Reverse Stock Splits

     B-182   

Blank Check Preferred Authorization

     B-182   

Adjust Par Value of Common Stock

     B-183   

Preemptive Rights

     B-183   

Debt Restructuring

     B-183   

STATE OF INCORPORATION

     B-185   

Voting on State Takeover Statutes

     B-185   

Reincorporations Proposals

     B-185   

Offshore Reincorporations and Tax Havens

     B-185   

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY & ACCOUNTABILITY

     B-186   

I.    GENERAL CSR RELATED

     B-187   

Special Policy Review and Shareholder Advisory Committees

     B-187   

Operations in Protected or Sensitive Areas

     B-187   

Land Use

     B-187   

International Financial Related

     B-187   

Affirm Political Non-Partisanship

     B-188   

Political Contributions Reporting & Disclosure

     B-188   

Military Sales

     B-189   

Report on Operations in Sensitive Regions or Countries

     B-189   

Recycling Policy

     B-189   

 

B-149


Table of Contents

II.  CLIMATE CHANGE ~ GLOBAL WARMING

     B-189   

Kyoto Compliance

     B-190   

Greenhouse Gas Emissions

     B-190   

Investment in Renewable Energy

     B-190   

Sustainability Reporting and Planning

     B-190   

Endorsement of CERES Principles

     B-191   

III. WORKPLACE PRACTICES & HUMAN RIGHTS

     B-191   

Equal Employment Opportunity

     B-191   

High-Performance Workplace

     B-192   

Non-Discrimination in Retirement Benefits

     B-192   

Fair Lending Reporting and Compliance

     B-192   

MacBride Principles

     B-193   

Contract Supplier Standards

     B-193   

Corporate Conduct and Labor Code of Conduct

     B-194   

IV. CONSUMER HEALTH & PUBLIC SAFETY

     B-194   

Phase-out or Label Products Containing Genetically Engineered Ingredients

     B-194   

Tobacco-Related Proposals

     B-194   

Toxic Emissions

     B-194   

Toxic Chemicals

     B-195   

Nuclear Safety

     B-195   

Concentrated Area Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

     B-195   

Pharmaceutical Product Reimportation

     B-195   

Pharmaceutical Product Pricing

     B-196   

 

B-150


Table of Contents

 

TAFT-HARTLEY ADVISORY SERVICES

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

This statement sets forth the proxy voting policy of RiskMetrics’ Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. The U.S. Department of Labor (DOL) has stated that the fiduciary act of managing plan assets that are shares of corporate stock includes the voting of proxies appurtenant to those shares of stock and that trustees may delegate this duty to an investment manager. ERISA section 3(38) defines an investment manager as any fiduciary who is registered as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisor Act of 1940. RiskMetrics is a registered investment adviser under the Investment Advisor Act of 1940.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote the proxies of its clients solely in the interest of their participants and beneficiaries and for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to them. The interests of participants and beneficiaries will not be subordinated to unrelated objectives. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall act with the care, skill, prudence, and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims. When proxies due to Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ clients have not been received, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will make reasonable efforts to obtain missing proxies. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is not responsible for voting proxies it does not receive.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall analyze each proxy on a case-by-case basis, informed by the guidelines elaborated below, subject to the requirement that all votes shall be cast solely in the long-term interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plans. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not intend for these guidelines to be exhaustive. Hundreds of issues appear on proxy ballots every year, and it is neither practical nor productive to fashion voting guidelines and policies which attempt to address every eventuality. Rather, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines are intended to cover the most significant and frequent proxy issues that arise. Issues not covered by the guidelines shall be voted in the interest of plan participants and beneficiaries of the plan based on a worker-owner view of long-term corporate value. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall revise its guidelines as events warrant and will remain in full conformity with the AFL-CIO proxy voting policy.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall report annually to its clients on proxy votes cast on their behalf. These proxy voting reports will demonstrate Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ compliance with its responsibilities and will facilitate clients’ monitoring of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. A copy of this Proxy Voting Policy Statement and Guidelines is provided to each client at the time Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is retained. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall provide its clients with revised copies of this proxy voting policy statement and guidelines whenever significant revisions have been made.

DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

Electing directors is the single most important stock ownership right that shareholders can exercise. By electing directors who share their views, shareholders can help to define performance standards against which management can be held accountable. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services holds directors to a high standard when voting on their election, qualifications, and compensation. We evaluate directors fairly and objectively, rewarding them for significant contributions and holding them ultimately accountable to shareholders for corporate performance. Institutional investors should use their voting rights in uncontested elections to influence financial performance and corporate strategies for achieving long term shareholder value.

Director accountability, independence and competence have become issues of prime importance to investors given the failings in oversight exposed by the global financial crisis. There is also concern over the environment in the boardrooms of certain markets, where past failures appear to be no impediment to continued or new appointments at major companies and may not be part of the evaluation process at companies in considering whether an individual is, or continues to be, fit for the role and best able to serve shareholder’s interests.

 

B-151


Table of Contents

 

Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

Votes concerning the entire board of directors and members of key board committees are examined using the following five factors:

 

   

Lack of independence of the full board and key board committees (fully independent audit, compensation, and nominating committees);

 

   

Performance of the board and key board committees (flagrant actions by management or the board, excessive risk-taking, problematic governance provisions, egregious compensation practices, poor accounting practices, imprudent use of corporate assets, etc.);

 

   

Failure of the board to properly respond to high withhold/against votes or majority votes on shareholder proposals;

 

   

Poor long-term corporate performance record relative to peers, S&P 500 or Russell 3000 Indices;

 

   

Diversity of board.

Votes on individual director nominees are always made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Specific director nominee WITHHOLD/AGAINST1 votes can be triggered by one or more of the following factors:

 

   

Lack of a board that is at least two-thirds (67 percent) independent — i.e. where the composition of non-independent board members is in excess of 33 percent of the entire board;

 

   

Attendance of director nominees at board meetings of less than 75 percent in one year without valid reason or explanation;

 

   

Lack of independence on key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, and nominating committees);

 

   

Failure to establish any key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, or nominating);

 

   

Directors serving on an excessive number of other boards which could compromise their primary duties of care and loyalty;

 

   

Chapter 7 bankruptcy, Securities & Exchange Commission (SEC) violations or fines, and criminal investigations by the Department of Justice (DOJ), Government Accounting Office (GAO) or any other federal agency;

 

   

Performance of compensation committee members and/or the entire board in relation to the approval of egregious or excessive executive compensation (including perquisites and cash and equity awards);

 

   

Performance of audit committee members concerning the approval of excessive non-audit fees, material weaknesses, and/or the lack of auditor ratification upon the proxy ballot;

 

   

If at the previous board election, any director received more than 50 percent withhold/against votes of the shares cast and the company has failed to address the underlying issue(s) that caused the high withhold/against vote;

 

   

The board failed to act on takeover offers where the majority of the shareholders tendered their shares;

 

   

The board lacks accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers;

 

   

If the company has a classified board and a continuing director is responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote, in addition

 

 

1

In general, companies with a plurality vote standard use “Withhold” as the valid contrary vote option in director elections; companies with a majority vote standard use “Against”. However, it will vary by company and the proxy must be checked to determine the valid contrary vote option for the particular company.

 

B-152


Table of Contents
 

to potential future withhold/against votes on that director, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may vote against or withhold votes from any or all of the nominees up for election, with the exception of new nominees;

 

   

The presence of problematic governance issues including interlocking directorships, multiple related-party transactions or other issues putting director independence at risk;

 

   

Inadequate CEO succession planning, including the absence of an emergency and non-emergency/orderly CEO succession plan;

 

   

Material failures of governance, stewardship, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company, failure to replace management as appropriate, egregious actions related to the director(s)’ service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from the members of the Audit Committee when:

 

   

Consulting (i.e. non-audit) fees paid to the auditor are excessive;

 

   

Auditor ratification is not included on the proxy ballot;

 

   

The company receives an adverse opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditor;

 

   

There is evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm; or

 

   

Poor accounting practices such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures, exist. Poor accounting practices may warrant voting against or withholding votes from the full board.

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from the members of the Compensation Committee when:

 

   

There is a negative correlation or disconnect between the CEO’s pay and company performance;

 

   

The company implements a repricing or an option exchange program, by buying out underwater options for stock, cash or other consideration or canceling underwater options and regranting options with a lower exercise price, without prior shareholder approval, even if such repricings are allowed in its equity plans;

 

   

The company fails to submit one-time transfers of stock options to a shareholder vote;

 

   

The company fails to fulfill the terms of a burn rate commitment they made to shareholders;

 

   

The company has backdated options (see Options Backdating policy);

 

   

There is evidence that management/board members are using company stock in hedging activities

 

   

The company has problematic compensation practices such as the provision of excise tax gross-ups, single and modified single trigger provisions, liberal change in control definitions, excessive executive perks and tax gross-ups on executive perks, excessive executive pay or disproportionately high compensation payouts tied to short-term financial results, etc. (see Probematic Pay Practices policy).

Problematic pay practices may warrant voting against or withholding votes from the entire board.

Voting for Director Nominees in Contested Elections

Contested elections of directors frequently occur when a board candidate or “dissident slate” seeks election for the purpose of achieving a significant change in corporate policy or control of seats on the board. Competing slates will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis with a number of considerations in mind. These include, but

 

B-153


Table of Contents

are not limited to, the following: personal qualifications of each candidate; the economic impact of the policies advanced by the dissident slate of nominees; and their expressed and demonstrated commitment to the interests of the shareholders of the company. Votes in a contested election of directors are evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis with the following seven factors in consideration:

 

   

Long-term financial performance of the target company relative to its industry;

 

   

Management’s track record;

 

   

Background to the proxy contest;

 

   

Qualifications of director nominees (both slates);

 

   

Strategic plan of dissident slate and quality of critique against management;

 

   

Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates);

 

   

Stock ownership positions.

Independent Directors

Board independence from management is of vital importance to a company and its shareholders. Accordingly, we believe votes should be cast in a manner that will encourage the independence of boards. Independence will be evaluated based upon a number of factors, including: employment by the company or an affiliate in an executive capacity; past or current employment by a firm that is one of the company’s paid advisors or consultants; personal services contract with the company; family relationships of an executive or director of the company; interlocks with other companies on which the company’s chairman or chief executive officer is also a board member; and service with a non-profit that receives significant contributions from the company.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from non-independent director nominees (insiders and affiliated outsiders) where the entire board is not at least two-thirds (67 percent) independent;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from non-independent director nominees (insiders and affiliated outsiders) when the nominating, compensation and audit committees are not fully independent;

 

   

Generally consider independent board members who have been on the board continually for a period longer than 10 years as affiliated outsiders;

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that all key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation and/or nominating) include independent directors exclusively;

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting that the board be comprised of a two-thirds majority of independent directors.

Non-Independent Chairman

Two major components at the top of every public company are the running of the board and the executive responsibility for the running of the company’s business. Many institutional investors believe there should be a clear division of responsibilities at the head of the company that will ensure a balance of power and authority, such that no one individual has unfettered powers of decision. When there is no clear division between the executive and board branches of a company, poor executive and/or board actions often go unchecked to the ultimate detriment of shareholders. Since executive compensation is so heavily correlated to the managerial power relationship in the boardroom, the separation of the CEO and chairman positions is a critical step in curtailing excessive pay, which ultimately can become a drain on shareholder value.

Arguments have been made that a smaller company and its shareholders can benefit from the full-time attention of a joint chairman and CEO. This may be so in select cases, and indeed, using a case-by-case review of

 

B-154


Table of Contents

circumstances there may be worthy exceptions. But, even in these cases, it is the general view of many institutions that a person should only serve in the position of joint CEO and chairman on a temporary basis, and that these positions should be separated following their provisional combination.

We strongly believe that the potential for conflicts of interest in the board’s supervisory and oversight duties trumps any possible corollary benefits that could ensue from a dual CEO/chairman scenario. Instead of having an ingrained quid pro quo situation whereby a company has a single leader overseeing both management and the boardroom, Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe that it is the board’s implicit duty to assume an impartial and objective role in overseeing the executive team’s overall performance. Shareholders interests are placed in jeopardy if the CEO of a company is required to report to a board that she/he also chairs.

Inherent in the chairman’s job description is the duty to assess the CEO’s performance. This objectivity is obviously compromised when a chairman is in charge of evaluating her/his own performance or has a past or present affiliation with management. Moreover, the unification of chairman and CEO poses a direct threat to the smooth functioning of the entire board process since it is the ultimate responsibility of the chairman to set the agenda, facilitate discussion, and make sure that directors are given complete access to information in order to make informed decisions.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from any non-independent director who serves as board chairman;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from a CEO who is also serving in the role of chairman at the same company;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals calling for the separation of the CEO and chairman positions;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals calling for a non-executive director to serve as chairman who is not a former CEO or senior-level executive of the company.

Excessive Directorships

As new regulations mandate that directors be more engaged and vigilant in protecting shareholder interests or else risk civil and/or criminal sanctions, board members are having to devote more time and effort to their oversight duties which, on average, were estimated to run to 280 hours per year, per board in 2005. Recent surveys of U.S. directors also confirm a desire for limiting board memberships, to between three and five seats. In view of the increased demands placed on corporate board members, Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe that directors who are overextended may be impairing their ability to serve as effective representatives of shareholders. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against or withhold from directors serving on an excessive number of other boards, which could compromise their primary duties of care and loyalty.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from directors serving on an excessive number of boards. As a general rule, vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from director nominees who are:

 

   

CEOs of publicly traded companies who serve on more than two public boards (i.e. more than one public boards other than their own board). NOTE: Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against or withhold from overboarded CEO directors only at their outside directorships and not at the company in which they presently serve as CEO); and

 

   

Non-CEO directors who serve on more than five public company boards.

Performance/Governance Evaluation for Directors

Many institutional investors believe long-term financial performance and the appropriateness of governance practices should be taken into consideration when determining vote recommendations with regard to directors in uncontested elections. When evaluating whether to vote against or withhold votes from director nominees, we

 

B-155


Table of Contents

will evaluate underperforming companies that exhibit sustained poor performance as measured by one- and three-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). For companies outside the Russell 3000 universe, a company will be considered to have exhibited sustained poor performance if it underperforms its peers or index on the basis of both one-year and three-year total shareholder returns.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services views deficient oversight mechanisms and the lack of board accountability to shareholders especially in the context of sustained poor performance, as problematic. As part of our framework for assessing director performance, we will also evaluate board accountability and oversight at companies that demonstrate sustained underperformance. A governance structure that discourages director accountability may lead to board and management entrenchment. For example, the existence of several anti-takeover provisions* has the cumulative effect of deterring legitimate tender offers, mergers, and corporate transactions that may have ultimately proved beneficial to shareholders. When a company maintains entrenchment devices, shareholders of poorly performing companies are left with few effective routes to beneficial change.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will assess the company’s response to the ongoing performance issues, and consider recent board and management changes, board independence, overall governance practices, and other factors that may have an impact on shareholders. If a company exhibits sustained poor performance coupled with a lack of board accountability and oversight, we may also consider the company’s five-year total shareholder return and five-year operational metrics in our evaluation.

*Problematic provisions include but are not limited to:

 

   

a classified board structure; o a supermajority vote requirement;

 

   

majority voting with no carve out for contested elections;

 

   

the inability for shareholders to call special meetings;

 

   

the inability for shareholders to act by written consent;

 

   

a dual-class structure; and/or

 

   

a non-shareholder approved poison pill.

Vote AGAINST/WITHHOLD votes from all director nominees if the board lacks accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers. Sustained poor performance is measured by one- and three-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). Sustained poor performance for companies outside the Russell 3000 universe, is defined as underperforming peers or index on the basis of both one-year and three-year total shareholder returns.

Director Diversity

Gender and ethnic diversity are important components on a company’s board. Diversity brings different perspectives to a board that in turn leads to a more varied approach to board issues. Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe that increasing diversity in the boardroom to better reflect a company’s workforce, customers, and community enhances shareholder value.

 

   

Support proposals asking the board to make greater efforts to search for qualified female and minority candidates for nomination to the board of directors;

 

   

Support endorsement of a policy of board inclusiveness;

 

   

Support reporting to shareholders on a company’s efforts to increase diversity on their boards.

 

B-156


Table of Contents

 

Stock Ownership Requirements

Corporate directors should own some amount of stock of the companies on which they serve as board members. Stock ownership is a simple method to align the interests of directors with company shareholders. Nevertheless, many highly qualified individuals such as academics and clergy who can offer valuable perspectives in boardrooms may be unable to purchase individual shares of stock. In such a circumstance, the preferred solution is to look at the board nominees individually and take stock ownership into consideration when voting on the merits of each candidate.

 

   

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals requiring directors to own a minimum amount of company stock in order to qualify as a director nominee or to remain on the board.

Classified Boards — Annual Elections

The ability to elect directors is the single most important use of the shareholder franchise, and all directors should be accountable on an annual basis. Annually elected boards provide the best governance system for accountability to shareholders. A classified board is a board that is divided into separate classes, with directors serving overlapping terms. A company with a classified board usually divides the board into three classes. Under this system, only one class of nominees comes up to shareholder vote at the AGM each year.

As a consequence of these staggered terms, shareholders only have the opportunity to vote on a single director approximately once every three years. A classified board makes it difficult to change control of the board through a proxy contest since it would normally take two years to gain control of a majority of board seats. Under a classified board, the possibility of management entrenchment greatly increases. Classified boards can reduce director accountability by shielding directors, at least for a certain period of time, from the consequences of their actions. Continuing directors who are responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level would avoid shareholders’ reactions to their actions because they would not be up for election in that year. Ultimately, in these cases, the full board should be responsible for the actions of its directors.

Many in management believe that staggered boards provide continuity. Some shareholders believe that in certain cases a staggered board can provide consistency and continuity in regard to decision-making and commitment that may be important to the long-term financial future of the company. Nevertheless, empirical evidence strongly suggests that staggered boards are generally not in the shareholders’ best interest. In addition to shielding directors from being held accountable by shareholders on an annual basis, a classified board can entrench management and effectively preclude most takeover bids or proxy contests.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management or shareholder proposals seeking to classify the board when the issue comes up for vote;

 

   

Vote FOR management or shareholder proposals to repeal a company’s classified board structure.

 

   

If the company has a classified board and a continuing director is responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote, in addition to potential future withhold/against votes on that director, we may vote against or withhold votes from any or all of the nominees up for election, with the exception of new nominees.

Board and Committee Size

While there is no hard and fast rule among institutional investors as to what may be an optimal size board, there is an acceptable range that companies should strive to meet and not exceed. A board that is too large may function inefficiently. Conversely, a board that is too small may allow the CEO to exert disproportionate influence or may stretch the time requirements of individual directors too thin.

 

B-157


Table of Contents

 

Proposals seeking to set board size will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Given that the preponderance of boards in the U.S. range between five and fifteen directors, many institutional investors believe this benchmark is a useful standard for evaluating such proposals.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST any proposal seeking to amend the company’s board size to fewer than five seats;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST any proposal seeking to amend the company’s board size to more than fifteen seats;

 

   

Evaluate board size on a CASE-BY-CASE basis and consider WITHHOLD or AGAINST votes or other action at companies that have fewer than five directors and more than 15 directors on their board.

Limit Term of Office

Those who support term limits argue that this requirement would bring new ideas and approaches on to a board. While term of office limitations can rid the board of non-performing directors over time, it can also unfairly force experienced and effective directors off the board. When evaluating shareholder proposals on director term limits, consider whether the company’s performance has been poor and whether problematic or entrenching governance provisions are in place at the company. Additionally, consider board independence, including whether the board chair is independent.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors.

Cumulative Voting

Most corporations provide that shareholders are entitled to cast one vote for each share owned. Under a cumulative voting scheme, the shareholder is permitted to have one vote per share for each director to be elected. Shareholders are permitted to apportion those votes in any manner they wish among the director candidates. Thus, under a cumulative voting scheme shareholders have the opportunity to elect a minority representative to a board by cumulating their votes, thereby ensuring minority representation for all sizes of shareholders.

For example, if there is a company with a ten-member board and 500 shares outstanding-the total number of votes that may be cast is 5,000. In this case a shareholder with 51 shares (10.2 percent of the outstanding shares) would be guaranteed one board seat because all votes may be cast for one candidate. Without cumulative voting, anyone controlling 51 percent of shares would control the election of all ten directors.

With the advent and prevalence of majority voting for director elections, shareholders now have greater flexibility in supporting candidates for a company’s board of directors. Cumulative voting and majority voting are two different voting mechanisms designed to achieve two different outcomes. While cumulative voting promotes the interests of minority shareholders by allowing them to get some representation on the board, majority voting promotes a democratic election of directors for all shareholders and ensures board accountability in uncontested elections. Though different in philosophic view, cumulative voting and majority voting can work together operationally, with companies electing to use majority voting for uncontested elections and cumulative voting for contested elections to increase accountability and ensure minority representation on the board.

In contested elections, similar to cumulative voting, proxy access allows shareholder access to the ballot without a veto from the nominating committee, but unlike cumulative voting, it also requires majority support to elect such directors.

At controlled companies, where majority insider control would preclude minority shareholders from having any representation on the board, cumulative voting would allow such representation and shareholder proposals for cumulative voting would be supported.

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals to eliminate cumulative voting;

 

B-158


Table of Contents

 

   

Generally vote FOR proposals to restore or provide for cumulative voting unless:

 

   

The company has proxy access or a similar structure2 to allow shareholders to nominate directors to the company’s ballot; and

 

   

The company has adopted a majority vote standard, with a carve-out for plurality voting in situations where there are more nominees than seats, and a director resignation policy to address failed elections.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals for cumulative voting at controlled companies (where insider voting power exceeds 50%).

Failure to Act on Shareholder Proposals Receiving Majority Support

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from all director nominees at a company that has ignored a shareholder proposal that was approved by a majority of the votes cast at the last annual meeting.

Votes Against or Withholds from Directors for Shareholder Rights Plan (i.e. Poison Pills)

Institutional investors view shareholder rights plans, or poison pills, as among the most onerous of takeover defenses that may serve to entrench management and have a detrimental impact on their long-term share value. While recognizing that boards have a fiduciary duty to use all available means to protect shareholders’ interests, as a best governance principle, boards should seek shareholder ratification of a poison pill (or an amendment thereof) within a reasonable period, to ensure that the features of the poison pill support the interests of shareholders and do not merely serve as a management entrenchment device. Boards that fail to do so should be held accountable for ultimately disregarding shareholders’ interests. In applying this principle to voting in uncontested director elections, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services considers the term of the pill an important factor, as shorter term pills are generally less onerous as a takeover defense when compared to longer term pills, and may in some cases provide the board with a valuable tool to maximize shareholder value in the event of an opportunistic offer.

Companies that unilaterally adopt a long-term pill should be subject to a more frequent review –- at least once every three years, beginning the first year following the adoption and extending until the pill has expired or been redeemed. However, we believe special consideration must be given to the combination of a poison pill and a classified board; together they create a powerful anti-takeover and entrenchment device. Instead of only reviewing such companies every 3 years, an annual review is more appropriate. Under a 3-year review, the same class of directors would be receiving against or withhold recommendations, while the other 2 classes of directors would be shielded. An annual review would hold responsible all directors of classified boards for not putting the pill to a shareholder vote.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees of the board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis) at a company that has a dead-hand or modified dead-hand poison pill in place. Vote AGAINST/WITHHOLD every year until this feature is removed;

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees of the board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis) if the board has adopted a poison pill with a term of more than 12 months (“long-term pill” ) or renewed any existing pill, including any “short-term” pill (12 months or less) without shareholder approval, and there is no requirement or commitment to put the pill to a binding shareholder vote. Review such companies with classified

 

 

2

A similar structure would be a structure that allows shareholders to nominate candidates who the company will include on the management ballot in addition to management’s nominees, and their bios are included in management’s proxy.

 

B-159


Table of Contents
 

boards every year, and such companies with annually-elected boards at least once every three years, and vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees if the company still maintains a non-shareholder-approved poison pill;

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from all nominees of the board of directors (except new nominees, who should be considered on a CASE-by-CASE basis) if the board makes a material, adverse change to an existing poison pill without shareholder approval;

 

   

Vote CASE-By-CASE on all nominees if the board adopts a poison pill with a term of 12 months or less (“short-term pill”) without shareholder approval, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

The date of the pill’s adoption relative to the date of next meeting of shareholders — i.e. whether the company had time to put the pill on ballot for shareholder ratification given the circumstances;

 

   

The issuer’s rationale;

 

   

The issuer’s governance structure and practices; and

 

   

The issuer’s track record of accountability to shareholders.

Shareholder Access to the Proxy (“Open Access”)

The current director election process as it exists leaves much to be desired. Companies currently nominate for election only one candidate for each board seat. Shareholders who oppose a candidate have no easy way to do so unless they are willing to undertake the considerable expense of running an independent candidate for the board. The only way for shareholders to register symbolic dissent about a certain director candidate is to simply “withhold” support from that nominee. But because directors are typically elected by a plurality (those nominees receiving the most votes win board seats), company nominees running unopposed are reelected.

 

   

Consider on a CASE-BY-CASE basis reasonably crafted shareholder proposals asking companies to voluntarily provide shareholders the ability to nominate director candidates to be included on management’s proxy card, taking into account the ownership threshold proposed in the resolution. Special consideration will be made at companies where there are legitimate concerns surrounding responsiveness to shareholders (such as not implementing majority-supported shareholder proposals), board and key committee independence, problematic governance and compensation practices, and past accounting or financial issues such as restatements.

Majority Threshold Voting Requirement for Director Elections

Shareholders have expressed strong support for precatory resolutions on majority threshold voting since 2005, with a number of proposals receiving majority support from shareholders. Taft-Hartley fiduciaries believe shareholders should have a greater voice in regard to the election of directors and view majority threshold voting as a viable alternative to the current deficiencies of the plurality system in the U.S.

 

   

Generally support reasonably crafted shareholders proposals calling for directors to be elected with an affirmative majority of votes cast and/or the elimination of the plurality standard for electing directors (including binding resolutions requesting that the board amend the company’s bylaws), provided the proposal includes a carve-out for a plurality voting standard when there are more director nominees than board seats (e.g. in contested elections).

 

   

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may recommend withhold/against votes on members of the board at companies without the carve-out for plurality voting in contested elections, as the use of a majority vote standard can act as an anti-takeover defense in contested elections. (e.g. although the dissident nominees may have received more shares cast, as long as the combination of withhold/against votes and the votes for the management nominees keep the dissident nominees under 50%, the management nominees will win, due to the holdover rules). This is clearly contradicts the expressed will of shareholders.

 

B-160


Table of Contents

 

   

In addition to supporting proposals seeking a majority vote standard in director elections, we also support a post-election “director resignation policy” that addresses the situation of holdover directors to accommodate both shareholder proposals and the need for stability and continuity of the board.

Establish An Office of the Board

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholders proposals requesting that the board establish an Office of the Board of Directors in order to facilitate direct communication between shareholders and non-management directors, unless the company has effectively demonstrated via public disclosure that it already has an established structure in place.

Director and Officer Indemnification ~ Liability Protection

Management proposals typically seek shareholder approval to adopt an amendment to the company’s charter to eliminate or limit the personal liability of directors to the company and its shareholders for monetary damages for any breach of fiduciary duty to the fullest extent permitted by state law. In contrast, shareholder proposals seek to provide for personal monetary liability for fiduciary breaches arising from gross negligence.

Each proposal addressing director liability will be evaluated consistent with this philosophy. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may support these proposals when the company persuasively argues that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but we may often oppose management proposals and support shareholder proposals in order to promote greater director accountability.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to limit or eliminate entirely director and officer liability in regards to: (i) breach of the director’s fiduciary “duty of loyalty” to shareholders; (ii) acts or omissions not made in “good faith” or involving intentional misconduct or knowledge of violations under the law; (iii) acts involving the unlawful purchases or redemptions of stock; (iv) payment of unlawful dividends; or (v) use of the position as director for receipt of improper personal benefits.

Indemnification

Indemnification is the payment by a company of the expenses of directors who become involved in litigation as a result of their service to a company. Proposals to indemnify a company’s directors differ from those to eliminate or reduce their liability because with indemnification directors may still be liable for an act or omission, but the company will bear the expense. Taft-Hartley fiduciaries may support these proposals when the company persuasively argues that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but will generally oppose indemnification when it is being proposed to insulate directors from actions that have already occurred.

 

   

Vote AGAINST indemnification proposals that would expand individual coverage beyond ordinary legal expenses to also cover specific acts of negligence which exceed the standard of mere carelessness that is regularly covered in board fiduciary indemnification;

 

   

Vote FOR only those proposals which provide expanded coverage in cases when a director’s or officer’s legal defense was unsuccessful if: (1) the director was found to have acted in good faith and in a manner that he/she reasonably believed was in the best interests of the company; and (2) only if the director’s legal expenses would be covered.

COMPENSATION

The housing market collapse and resulting credit crisis have resulted in significant erosion of shareholder value, unprecedented levels of market volatility, and continuing lack of confidence among financial market participants. Many Taft-Hartley trustees are questioning the role of executive compensation in incentivizing inappropriate or excessive risk-taking behavior by executives that could threaten a corporation’s long-term viability. Further, generous severance packages and other payments to departing executives of failed institutions have heightened attention on the issue of pay for performance.

 

B-161


Table of Contents

 

Trustees of Taft-Hartley funds, which have lost significant value in their investments as a result of the financial crisis, have little patience for “pay for failure” and continue to press for the adoption of executive compensation practices aimed at creating and sustaining long-term shareholder value.

Companies have long argued that legally binding executive compensation obligations cannot be modified. The Capital Purchase Program implemented under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, the “bail out” program for the U.S. financial system, set the tone for executive compensation reform and requires participating firms to accept certain limits and requirements on executive compensation, regardless of existing contractual arrangements. A number of firms have agreed to these requirements.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that executive pay programs should be fair, competitive, reasonable, and appropriate, and that pay for performance should be a central tenet in executive compensation philosophy.

Examples of best pay practices include:

Employment contracts: Companies should enter into employment contracts under limited circumstances for a short time period (e.g., new executive hires for a three-year contract) for limited executives. The contracts should not have automatic renewal feature and should have a specified termination date.

Severance agreements: Severance provisions should not be so appealing that they become an incentive for the executive to be terminated. The severance formula should be reasonable and not overly generous to the executive (e.g., use maximum severance multiple of 3X pay; use pro-rated target/average historical bonus and not maximum bonus). Failure to renew employment contract, termination under questionable events or for poor performance should not constitute “good reason” for termination with severance payments.

Change-in-control payments: Change-in-control payments should be “double-triggered” — i.e. be payouts should only made when there is a significant change in company ownership structure, and when there is a loss of employment or substantial change in job duties associated with the change in company ownership structure. Change-in-control provisions should exclude excise tax gross-ups and should not authorize the acceleration of vesting of equity awards upon a change in control unless provided under a double-trigger scenario. Similarly, change in control provisions in equity plans should be double-triggered. A change in control event should not result in an acceleration of vesting of all unvested stock options or lapsing of vesting/performance requirements on restricted stock/performance shares, unless there is a loss of employment or substantial change in job duties.

Supplemental executive retirement plans (SERPs): SERPs should not include sweeteners that can increase the payout value significantly or even exponentially, such as additional years of service credited for pension calculations, or inclusion of variable pay (e.g. bonuses and equity awards) into the formula. Pension formulas should not include extraordinary annual bonuses paid close to the time of retirement and should be based on an average, not the maximum, level of compensation earned.

Deferred compensation: Above-market returns or guaranteed minimum returns should not be applied on deferred compensation.

Disclosure practices: The Compensation, Discussion and Analysis should be written in plain English, with as little “legalese” as possible and formatted using section headers, bulleted lists, tables and charts where possible to ease reader comprehension. Ultimately, the document should provide detail and rationale regarding compensation, strategy, pay mix, goals/metrics, challenges, competition and pay for performance linkage, etc. in a narrative fashion.

Responsible use of company stock: Companies should adopt policies that prohibit executives from speculating in company’s stock or using company stock in hedging activities, such as “cashless” collars, forward

 

B-162


Table of Contents

sales, equity swaps or other similar arrangements. Such behavior undermines the ultimate alignment with long-term shareholders’ interests. In addition, the policy should prohibit or discourage the use of company stock as collateral for margin loans, to avoid any potential sudden stock sales (required upon margin calls) that could have a negative impact on the company’s stock price.

Long-term focus: Executive compensation programs should be designed to support companies’ long-term strategic goals. A short-term focus on performance does not necessarily create sustainable shareholder value. Instead, long-term goals may be sacrificed to achieve short-term expectations to the detriment of shareholder value, as evidenced by the financial crisis.

Compensation programs embedding a long-term focus with respect to company goals better align with the long-term interests of shareholders. Granting stock options and restricted stock to executives that vest in five years does not necessarily provide a long-term focus, as executives can sell off the company shares once they vest. However, requiring senior executives to hold company stock until retirement or after retirement can encourage a long-term focus on company performance.

Stock Option Plans

Compensation to executive and other senior level employees should be strongly correlated to sustained performance. Stock options, restricted stock and other forms of non-cash compensation should be performance-based with an eye toward improving long-term corporate value. Well-designed stock option plans can align the interests of executives and shareholders by providing that executives benefit when stock prices rise so that the employees of the company, along with shareholders, prosper together. Likewise, option plans should not allow for the benefits of share price gains without the risk of share price declines. Poorly designed stock option plans can encourage excessive risk-taking behavior and incentivize executives to pursue corporate strategies that promote short-term stock price to the ultimate detriment of long-term shareholder value.

Many plans sponsored by management provide goals so easily attained that executives can realize massive rewards even though shareholder value is not created. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports option plans when they provide legitimately challenging performance targets that serve to truly motivate executives in the pursuit of sustained superior performance. Moreover, equity pay plans should be designed in a fashion that ensures executive compensation is veritably performance driven and “at risk” such that executives are penalized (by either reducing or withholding compensation) for failure to meet pre-determined performance hurdles. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose those plans that offer unreasonable benefits to executives that are not generally available to other shareholders or employees.

Methodology for Analyzing Pay Plans

The theory that stock options are beneficial to shareholders because they motivate management and align the interests of investors with those of executives is no longer held sacrosanct. Indeed, many academic studies have found that there is limited correlation between executive stock ownership and company performance. Misused stock options can give executives an incentive to inflate their company’s earnings, take excessive risks, and make irresponsibly optimistic forecasts in order to keep stock prices high and their paychecks gargantuan.

Therefore, it is vital for shareholders to fully analyze all equity plans that appear on ballot. In general, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services evaluates executive and director compensation plans on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. When evaluating equity-based compensation items on ballot, the following elements will be considered:

Primary Considerations:

 

   

Dilution: Vote AGAINST plans in which the potential voting power dilution (VPD) of all shares outstanding exceeds ten percent;

 

B-163


Table of Contents
   

Full Market Value: Awards must be granted at 100 percent of fair market value on the date of grant. However, in instances when a plan is open to broad-based employee participation and excludes the five most highly compensated employees, we accept a 15 percent discount;

 

   

Burn Rate: Vote AGAINST plans where the annual burn rate exceeds industry and index burn rates over a three-year period;

 

   

Liberal Definition of Change-in-Control: Vote AGAINST equity plans if the plan provides for the accelerated vesting of equity awards even though an actual change in control may not occur. Examples of such a definition could include, but are not limited to, announcement or commencement of a tender offer, provisions for acceleration upon a “potential” takeover, shareholder approval of a merger or other transactions, or similar language;

 

   

Problematic Pay Practices: Vote AGAINST equity plans if the plan is a vehicle for problematic pay practices (e.g. if the plan allows for change-in-control payouts that are single triggered).

Secondary Considerations:

 

   

Executive Concentration Ratio: Vote AGAINST plans where the annual grant rate to the top five executives (“named officers”) exceeds one percent of shares outstanding;

 

   

Pay-For-Performance Metric: Vote AGAINST plans where CEO pay and the company’s performance is incongruous, as measured against industry peers over one and three-year periods, or if the performance criteria is not disclosed;

 

   

Evergreen Features: Vote AGAINST plans that reserve a specified percentage of outstanding shares for award each year instead of having a termination date;

 

   

Repricing: Vote AGAINST plans if the company’s policy permits repricing of “underwater” options or if the company has a history of repricing past options;

 

   

Loans: Vote AGAINST the plan if the plan administrator may provide loans to officers to assist in exercising the awards.

Voting Power Dilution (VPD) Calculation

Voting power dilution, or VPD, measures the amount of voting power represented by the number of shares reserved over the life of the plan. Industry norm dictates that ten percent dilution over the life of a ten-year plan is reasonable for most mature companies. Restricted stock plans or stand-alone stock bonus plans that are not coupled with stock option plans can be held to a lower dilution cap.

Voting power dilution may be calculated using the following formula:

 

  A: Shares reserved for this amendment or plan;

 

  B: Shares available under this plan and/or continuing plans prior to proposed amendment;

 

  C: Shares granted but unexercised under this plan and/or continuing plans;

 

  D: All outstanding shares plus any convertible equity, outstanding warrants, or debt.

 

The formula can be applied as follows:

      A + B + C    
  A + B + C + D

Fair Market Value, Dilution and Repricing

Consideration will be made as to whether the proposed plan is being offered at fair market value or at a discount; whether the plan excessively dilutes the earnings per share of the outstanding shares; and whether the plan gives management the ability to replace or reprice “underwater” options. Repricing is an amendment to a

 

B-164


Table of Contents

previously granted stock option contract that reduces the option exercise price. Options are “underwater” when their current price is below the current option contract price. Options can also be repriced through cancellations and re-grants. The typical new grant would have a ten-year term, new vesting restrictions, and a lower exercise price reflecting the current lower market price.

Burn Rate

The annual burn rate is a measure of dilution that illustrates how rapidly a company is deploying shares reserved for equity compensation plans. The burn or run rate is calculated by dividing the number of shares pursuant to awards granted in a given year by the number of shares outstanding. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services benchmarks a company’s burn rate against three-year industry and primary index burn rates, and generally oppose plans whose average three-year burn rates exceed the greater of: (1) the mean plus one standard deviation of the company’s GICS group segmented by Russell 3000 index and non-Russell 3000 index; or (2) two percent of weighted common shares outstanding. The three-year burn rate policy does not apply to non-employee director plans unless outside directors receive a significant portion of shares each year.

Executive Concentration Ratio

In examining stock option awards, restricted stock and other forms of long-term incentives, it is important to consider internal pay equity; that is, the concentration and distribution of equity awards to a company’s top five executives (“named officers”) as a percentage of overall grants. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider voting against equity compensation plans whose annual grant rate to top executives exceeds one percent of shares outstanding.

Principle of Pay-For-Performance

Stock-based pay is often the main driver for excessive executive compensation, which is fueled by poor administration of the plan. Therefore, it is important to closely examine any discrepancies between increases in CEO pay and total shareholder returns against those of peer firms over a one- three- and five-year timeframe in assessing equity-based compensation plans.

Significant disparities between pay and performance warrants votes against or withholding from Compensation Committee members who are responsible for overseeing the company’s compensation schemes, or the entire board if the whole board was involved in and contributed to egregious compensation practices. If the equity component is the source of the imbalance, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider opposing the equity plan in which the CEO participates.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from the Compensation Committee members when the company has a pay-for-performance disconnect.

Evergreen Provisions

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose plans that reserve a specified percentage of outstanding shares for award each year (evergreen plans) instead of having a termination date. Such plans provide for an automatic increase in the shares available for grant with or without limits on an annual basis. Because they represent a transfer of shareholder value and have a dilutive impact on a regular basis, evergreen plans are expensive to shareholders. Evergreen features also minimize the frequency that companies seek shareholder approval in increasing the number of shares available under the plan.

Option Exchange Programs/Repricing Options

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on management proposals seeking approval to exchange/reprice options taking into consideration the following factors:

 

   

Historic trading patterns: the stock price should not be so volatile that the options are likely to be back “in-the-money” over the near term;

 

B-165


Table of Contents

 

   

Rationale for the re-pricing: was the stock price decline beyond management’s control?

 

   

Option vesting: does the new option vest immediately or is there a black-out period?

 

   

Term of the option: the term should remain the same as that of the replaced option;

 

   

Exercise price: should be set at fair market or a premium to market;

 

   

Participants: the plan should be broad-based and executive officers and directors should be excluded;

 

   

Is this a value-for-value exchange?

 

   

Are surrendered stock options added back to the plan reserve?

If the surrendered options are added back to the equity plans for re-issuance, then we will also take into consideration the impact on the company’s equity plans and its three-year average burn rate.

In addition to the above considerations, we will evaluate the intent, rationale, and timing of the repricing proposal. The proposal should clearly articulate why the board is choosing to conduct an exchange program at this point in time. Repricing underwater options after a recent precipitous drop in the company’s stock price demonstrates poor timing. We do not view market deterioration, in and of itself, as an acceptable reason for companies to reprice stock options and/or reset goals under performance plans. Repricing after a recent decline in stock price triggers additional scrutiny and may warrant a vote AGAINST the proposal. At a minimum, the decline should not have happened within the past year. Also, consider the terms of the surrendered options, such as the grant date, exercise price and vesting schedule. Grant dates of surrendered options should be far enough back (two to three years) so as not to suggest that repricings are being done to take advantage of short-term downward price movements. Similarly, the exercise price of surrendered options should be above the 52-week high for the stock price.

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

Problematic Compensation Practices and Compensation Committee Performance

Poor disclosure, the absence or non-transparency of disclosure and poor plan design of compensation payouts lead to excessive executive compensation practices that are detrimental to shareholders. Poorly designed plans or those lacking in transparency can be reflective of a poorly performing compensation committee.

Companies are expected to meet a minimum standard of tally sheet disclosure as to allow shareholders to readily assess the total executive pay package, understand the actual linkage between pay and performance, and mitigate misinformation to shareholders. The SEC has issued rules on executive and director compensation that require expansive disclosure and a total compensation figure for each of the named executive officers.

Executive compensation will continue to be in the spotlight in the ensuing years, particularly when shareholders will have access to more complete information. In the absence of disclosure that would necessitate a higher level of scrutiny, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may also consider voting against or withholding from the compensation committee for failure to provide pertinent information in the Comensasion Discussion and Analysis (CD&A) report.

 

   

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider voting AGAINST or WITHHOLDING votes from compensation committee members and/or the CEO on a CASE-BY-CASE basis if the company has problematic compensation practices. In addition, we may consider a vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD vote from the entire board if the whole board was involved in and contributed to egregious compensation. Problematic compensation practices include, but are not limited to, the following:

Non-Performance based Compensation Elements

 

   

Multi-year guarantees for salary increases, non-performance based bonuses, and equity compensation;

 

B-166


Table of Contents

 

   

Egregious SERP (Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans) payouts (e.g. inclusion of additional years of service not earned or inclusion of performance-based equity awards in the pension calculation);

 

   

Excessive perks for current, former and/or retired executives (e.g. personal use of corporate aircraft, personal security systems maintenance and/or installation, car allowances, extraordinary relocation benefits, and/or other inappropriate arrangements);

 

   

Income tax reimbursements (gross-ups) for any executive perquisites or other payments;

 

   

Excessive severance and/or change-in-control provisions (e.g. payments upon an executive’s termination in connection with performance failure, provisions for the payment of excise tax gross-ups (including modified gross-ups) and/or modified single-triggers — under which an executive may voluntarily depart for any reason and still receive change-in-control severance payments — );

 

   

Change-in-control payouts without loss of job or substantial diminution of job duties (“single-triggers”);

 

   

Liberal change-in-control definitions in individual contracts or equity plans which could result in payments to executives without an actual change in control occurring;

 

   

Payment of dividends or dividend equivalents on unvested/unearned performance awards;

 

   

Executives using company stock in hedging activities, such as “cashless” collars, forward sales, equity swaps or other similar arrangements;

 

   

Repricing or replacing of underwater stock options/stock appreciation rights without prior shareholder approval (including cash buyouts and voluntary surrender/subsequent regrant of underwater options);

 

   

Performance metrics that are changed, canceled or replaced during the performance period without adequate explanation of the action and the link to performance;

 

   

New CEO with overly generous new hire package (e.g., including excessive “make whole” provisions).

Incentives that may Motivate Excessive Risk-Taking

 

   

Guaranteed bonuses or other abnormally large bonus payouts without justifiable performance linkage or appropriate disclosure;

 

   

Mega annual equity grants that provide unlimited upside with no downside risk;

 

   

A single performance metric used for short- and long-term plans;

 

   

High pay opportunities relative to industry peers;

 

   

Disproportionate supplemental pensions.

Factors that potentially mitigate the impact of risky incentives include rigorous claw-back provisions, robust stock ownership/holding guidelines, and substantive bonus deferral/escrowing programs.

Other Problematic Practices

 

   

Poor Disclosure Practices (e.g. unclear explanation of how the CEO is involved in the pay setting process, retrospective performance targets and methodology not discussed, methodology for benchmarking practices and/or peer group not disclosed and explained);

 

   

Internal pay disparity (excessive differential between CEO total pay and that of next highest-paid named executive officer);

 

B-167


Table of Contents

 

   

Options backdating (covered in a separate policy);

 

   

Failure to respond to majority-supported shareholder proposals on executive pay topics;

 

   

Failure to respond to concerns raised in connection with significant opposition to Management Say on Pay proposals.

Moreover, if there is an equity plan proposal on the ballot and the plan is a vehicle for poor pay practices, we may consider voting against the proposal based on past compensation practices.

Restricted Stock

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the use of performance-vesting restricted stock as long as the absolute amount of restricted stock being granted is a reasonable proportion of an executive’s overall compensation. The best way to align the interests of executives with shareholders is through direct stock holdings, coupled with at-risk variable compensation that is tied to explicit and challenging performance benchmarks. Performance-vesting restricted stock both adds to executives direct share holdings and incorporates at-risk features.

To reward performance and not job tenure, restricted stock vesting requirements should be performance-based rather than time lapsing. Such plans should explicitly define the performance criteria for awards to senior executives and may include a variety of corporate performance measures in addition to the use of stock price targets. In addition, executives should be required to hold their vested restricted stock as long as they remain employees of the company.

Executive Holding Periods

Senior level executives should be required to hold a substantial portion of their equity compensation awards, including shares received from option exercises (e.g. 75% of their after-tax stock option proceeds), while they are employed at a company or even into retirement. Equity compensation awards are intended to align management interests with those of shareholders, and allowing executives to sell these shares while they are employees of the company undermines this purpose. Given the large size of a typical annual equity compensation award, holding requirements that are based on a multiple of cash compensation may be inadequate.

Performance-Based Options

Stock options are intended to align the interests of management with those of shareholders. However, stock option grants without performance-based elements can excessively compensate executives for stock increases due solely to a general stock market rise, rather than improved or superior company stock performance. When option grants reach the hundreds of thousands, a relatively small increase in the share price may permit executives to reap millions of dollars without providing material benefits to shareholders.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services advocates for performance-based awards — such as premium-priced or indexed — which encourage executives to outperform peers, certain indices, or the broader market rather than being rewarded for any minimal rise in the share price, which can occur if there are not empirical performance measures incorporated into the structure of the options. Additionally, it should be noted that performance-accelerated vesting and premium priced options allow fixed plan accounting, whereas performance-vested and indexed options entail certain expensing requirements.

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals that seek to provide for performance-based options such as indexed and/or premium priced options.

 

B-168


Table of Contents

 

Options Backdating

Options backdating has serious implications and has resulted in financial restatements, delisting of companies, and/or the termination of executives or directors. When options backdating has taken place, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may recommend voting AGAINST or WITHHOLDING from the compensation committee, depending on the severity of the practices and the subsequent corrective actions on the part of the board. We will adopt a CASE-BY-CASE approach to the options backdating issue to differentiate companies that had sloppy administration vs. those that had committed fraud, as well as those companies which have since taken corrective action. Instances in which companies have committed fraud are more disconcerting, and Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will look to them to adopt formal policies to ensure that such practices will not reoccur in the future.

In recommending votes against or withhold votes from the compensation committee members who oversaw the questionable options grant practices or from current compensation committee members who fail to respond to the issue proactively, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider several factors, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Reason and motive for the options backdating issue, such as inadvertent vs. deliberate grant date changes;

 

   

Duration of options backdating;

 

   

Size of restatement due to options backdating;

 

   

Corrective actions taken by the board or compensation committee, such as canceling or repricing backdated options, or recoupment of option gains on backdated grants;

 

   

Adoption of a grant policy that prohibits backdating, and creation of a fixed grant schedule or window period for equity grants going forward.

Pension Plan Income Accounting

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals to exclude pension plan income in the calculation of earnings used in determining executive bonuses/compensation.

Shareholder Proposals to Limit Executive and Director Pay

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals that seek additional disclosure of executive and director pay information;

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals that seek to eliminate outside directors’ retirement benefits;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all other shareholder proposals that seek to limit executive and director pay. This includes shareholder proposals that seek to link executive compensation to customer, employee, or stakeholder satisfaction.

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Shareholder Proposals

 

   

Generally, vote FOR shareholder proposals that call for non-binding shareholder ratification of the compensation of the Named Executive Officers and the accompanying narrative disclosure of material factors provided to understand the Summary Compensation Table.

Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay) Management Proposals

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on management proposals for an advisory vote on executive compensation, considering the following factors:

 

   

Evaluation of performance metrics in short-term and long-term plans, considering i) the measures, goals, and target awards reported by the company for executives’ short- and long-term incentive

 

B-169


Table of Contents
 

awards; ii) whether the metrics are disclosed; iii) whether the company explains their alignment with the company’s business strategy; and iv) whether the goals appear to be sufficiently challenging in relation to resulting payouts.

 

   

Evaluation of peer group benchmarking used to set target pay or award opportunities, including i) the rationale stated by the company for constituents in its pay benchmarking peer group; and ii) as the benchmark targets it uses to set or validate executives’ pay.

 

   

Balance of performance-based versus non-performance-based pay, considering i) the ratio of performance-based versus non-performance-based CEO pay elements; ii) presence of concerns about other compensation factors such as performance metrics/goals, benchmarking practices, and pay-for-performance disconnects.

 

   

Prescence of problematic pay practices (see Problematic Compensation Practices above)

 

   

Poor compensation disclosure practices.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management say on pay proposals where there is a misalignment between CEO pay and company performance, the company maintains problematic pay practices, the board exhibits poor communication and responsiveness to shareholders or if the board has failed to demonstrate good stewardship of investors’ interests regarding executive compensation practices.

Compensation Consultants — Disclosure of Board or Company’s Utilization

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking disclosure regarding the Company, Board, or Compensation Committee’s use of compensation consultants, such as company name, business relationship(s) and fees paid.

Golden and Tin Parachutes

Golden parachutes are designed to protect the employees of a corporation in the event of a change-in-control. Under most golden parachute agreements, senior level management employees receive a lump sum payout triggered by a change-in-control at usually two to three times their current base salary. Increasingly, companies that have golden parachute agreements for senior level executives are extending coverage for all their employees via “tin” parachutes. The SEC requires disclosure of all golden parachute arrangements in the proxy statement, while disclosure of tin parachutes in company filings is not required at this time.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to all have golden parachute agreements submitted for shareholder ratification;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST all proposals to ratify golden parachutes;

 

   

Vote on tin parachutes on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Executive Perks and Retirement/Death Benefits

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports enhanced disclosure and shareholder oversight of executive benefits and other in-kind retirement perquisites. For example, compensation devices like executive pensions (SERPs), deferred compensation plans, below-market-rate loans or guaranteed post-retirement consulting fees can amount to significant liabilities to shareholders and it is often difficult for investors to find adequate disclosure of their full terms. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes any perquisite or benefit to executives that exceeds what is generally offered to other company employees. From a shareholder prospective, the cost of these executive entitlements would be better allocated to performance-based forms of executive compensation during their term in office.

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals requesting to put extraordinary benefits contained in SERP agreements to a shareholder vote unless the company’s executive pension plans do not contain excessive benefits beyond what is offered under employee-wide plans.

 

B-170


Table of Contents

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling companies to adopt a policy of discontinuing or obtaining shareholder approval for any future agreements and corporate policies that could oblige the company to make payments or awards following the death of a senior executive in the form of unearned salary or bonuses, accelerated vesting or the continuation in force of unvested equity grants, perquisites and other payments or awards made in lieu of compensation. This would not apply to any benefit programs or equity plan proposals that the broad-based employee population is eligible.

Employee Stock Ownership Plans (ESOPs)

An Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) is an employee benefit plan that makes the employees of a company also owners of stock in that company. Recent academic research of the performance of ESOPs in closely held companies found that ESOPs appear to increase overall sales, employment, and sales per employee over what would have been expected absent an ESOP. Studies have also found that companies with an ESOP are also more likely to still be in business several years later, and are more likely to have other retirement oriented benefit plans than comparable non-ESOP companies.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that request shareholder approval in order to implement an ESOP or to increase authorized shares for existing ESOPs except in cases when the number of shares allocated to the ESOP is deemed excessive (i.e. generally greater than five percent of outstanding shares).

OBRA-Related Compensation Proposals

 

   

Vote FOR amendments that place a cap on annual grants or amend administrative features;

 

   

Vote FOR plans that simply amend shareholder-approved plans to include administrative features or place a cap on the annual grants that any one participant may receive in order to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) of OBRA.

Amendments to Add Performance-Based Goals

Section 162(m) of the IRS Code Section limits the deductibility of compensation in excess of $1 million to a named executive officer unless certain prescribed actions are taken including shareholder approval and the establishment of performance goals.

 

   

Vote FOR amendments to add performance goals to existing compensation plans to comply with the provisions of Section 162(m) of OBRA, unless they are inappropriate.

Amendments to Increase Shares and Retain Tax Deductions Under OBRA

Amendments to existing plans to increase shares reserved and to qualify the plan for favorable tax treatment under the provisions of Section 162(m) should be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Approval of Cash or Cash-and-Stock Bonus Plans

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST cash or cash-and-stock bonus plans to exempt the compensation from taxes under the provisions of Section 162(m) of OBRA if the plan provides for awards to individual participants in excess of $2 million a year;

 

   

Vote AGAINST plans that are deemed to be excessive because they are not justified by performance measures;

 

   

Vote AGAINST plans if the compensation committee does not fully consist of independent outsiders, as defined by Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ definition of director independence.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-171


Table of Contents

 

AUDITORS

Auditors play an integral role in certifying the integrity and reliability of corporate financial statements on which investors rely to gauge the financial well being of a company and the viability of an investment. The well-documented auditor-facilitated bankruptcies and scandals at several large public companies in recent years underscore the catastrophic consequences that investors can suffer when the audit process breaks down.

Auditor Independence

The recent wave of accounting scandals at companies illuminate the need to ensure auditor independence in the face of selling consulting services to audit clients. At the large four accounting firms, revenues from non-audit services grew from 13% of total revenues in 1981 to half of total revenue in 2000. A study of over 1,200 US companies in the S&P 500, Mid Cap, and Small Cap indices found that 72% of fees paid to auditors in 2002 were for non-audit services, exactly the same level as 2001. We believe that this ratio should be reversed and that non-audit fees should make up no more than one-quarter of all fees paid to the auditor so as to properly discourage even the appearance of any undue influence upon an auditor’s objectivity.

Under SEC rules, disclosed categories of professional fees paid for audit and non-audit services are as follows: (1) Audit Fees, (2) Audit-Related Fees, (3) Tax Fees, and (4) All Other Fees. Under the revised reporting requirements, a company will also be required to describe — in qualitative terms — the types of services provided under the three categories other than Audit Fees. The following fee categories are defined as: A) tax compliance or preparation fees are excluded from our calculations of non-audit fees; and B) fees for consulting services for tax-avoidance strategies and tax shelters will be included in “other fees” and will be considered non-audit fees if the proxy disclosure does not indicate the nature of the tax services. In circumstances where “Other” fees include fees related to significant one-time capital structure events: initial public offerings, bankruptcy emergence, and spin-offs; and the company makes public disclosure of the amount and nature of those fees which are an exception to the standard “non-audit fee” category, then such fees may be excluded from the non-audit fees considered in determining the ratio of non-audit to audit/audit-related fees/tax compliance and preparation for purposes of determining whether non-audit fees are excessive.

As auditors are the backbone upon which a company’s financial health is measured, auditor independence is absolutely essential for rendering objective opinions upon which investors then rely. When an auditor is paid excessive consulting fees in addition to fees paid for auditing, the company-auditor relationship is left open to conflicts of interest.

Auditor Ratification

The ratification of auditors is an important component of good governance. In light of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and increased shareholder scrutiny, some companies are opting to take auditor ratification off the ballot. Neglecting to include the ratification of auditors on the proxy takes away the fundamental shareholder tight to ratify the company’s choice of auditor. Whereas shareholder ratification of auditors was once considered routine by many shareowners, the subsequent accounting scandals have caused shareholders to be more vigilant about the integrity of the auditors certifying their companies’ financial statements. It is now viewed as best practice for companies to place the item on ballot.

Although U.S. companies are not legally required to allow shareholders to ratify their appointment of independent auditors, roughly 60% of S&P 500 companies allow for shareholder ratification of their auditors. Submission of the audit firm for approval at the annual meeting on an annual basis gives shareholders the means to weigh in on their satisfaction (or lack thereof) on the auditor’s independent execution of their duties.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services firmly believes mandatory auditor ratification is in line with sound and transparent corporate governance and remains an important mechanism to ensure the integrity of the auditor’s

 

B-172


Table of Contents

work. In the absence of legislation mandating shareholder ratification of auditors, the failure by a company to present its selection of auditors for shareholder ratification should be discouraged as it undermines good governance and disenfranchises shareholders.

Proposals to ratify auditors is examined for potential conflicts of interest, with particular attention to the fees paid to the auditor, as well as whether the ratification of auditors has been put up for shareholder vote.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to ratify auditors when the amount of audit fees is equal to or greater than three times (75 percent) the amount paid for consulting, unless: i) An auditor has a financial interest in or association with the company, and is therefore not independent; or ii) There is reason to believe that the independent auditor has rendered an opinion which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to ratify auditors when the amount of non-audit consulting fees exceeds a quarter of all fees paid to the auditor;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking to limit companies from buying consulting services from their auditor.

Auditor Rotation

Long-term relationships between auditors and their clients can impede auditor independence, objectivity and professional skepticism. Such long-standing relationships foster an undesirable coziness between audit firms and their clients, which can cause the auditors to lose their independence and become less questioning especially where lucrative contracts for the provision of non-audit consulting services are involved. Mandatory auditor rotation is a widely supported safeguard against improper audits and is viewed by many as an effective mechanism for mitigating the potential risks borne by long-term auditor-client relationships.

Proponents of compulsory audit firm rotation contend that rotation policies promote objectivity and independence among auditors and minimize the scope of vested interests developing in the audit. Opponents of audit firm rotation argue that regular re-tendering is a costly practice, likely to reduce audit quality and increase the risk of audit failure in the early years due to the time required to gain cumulative knowledge of an often complex and geographically diverse business. A solution around this apparent negative effect of mandatory rotation is to keep a longer rotation period.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recommends that companies not maintain the same audit firm in excess of seven years, and will consider voting against auditors if their tenure at a company exceeds seven years. A revolving seven-year rotation period allows the auditor to develop cumulative knowledge of a company’s business and the effect of changes in the business along with the corresponding changes in its risks, thereby enhancing the quality of the audit and trammeling potential loss of auditor objectivity and independence. Many institutional investors argue that the increased costs associated with compulsory auditor rotation are a lesser evil vis-à-vis the larger evil of the costs to shareholders when the objectionable coziness between clients and long-standing auditors leads to gross erosion of shareholder value.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals to ensure auditor independence through measures such as mandatory auditor rotation (no less than every seven years).

Auditor Indemnification and Limitation of Liability

Indemnification clauses allow auditors to avoid liability for potential damages, including punitive damages. Eliminating concerns about being sued for carelessness could lead to; 1) potential impairment of external auditor independence and impartiality by contractual clauses limiting their liability; and 2) a decrease the quality and reliability of the audit given the lack of consequence for an inadequate audit.

 

B-173


Table of Contents

 

Given the substantial settlements against auditors in recent years for poor audit practices and the cost of such insurance to the company and its shareholders, there are legitimate concerns over the broader use of indemnification clauses. Such agreements may weaken the objectivity, impartiality and performance of audit firms. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes it is important for shareholders to understand the full risks and implications of these agreements and determine what impact they could have on shareholder value. At the present time, however, due to poor disclosure in this area, it is difficult to identify the existence and extent of limited liability provisions and auditor agreements, and investors lack the information needed to make informed decisions regarding these agreements.

Without uniform disclosure, it is difficult to consistently apply policy and make informed vote recommendations. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews the use of indemnification clauses and limited liability provisions in auditor agreements on a case-by-case basis, when disclosure is present.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from Audit Committee members if there is persuasive evidence that the audit committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.

Disclosures Under Section 404 of Sarbanes-Oxley Act

Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires that companies document and assess the effectiveness of their internal financial controls. Beginning in 2005, most public companies must obtain annual attestation of the effectiveness of their internal controls over financial reporting from their outside auditors. Companies with significant material weaknesses identified in the Section 404 disclosures potentially have ineffective internal financial reporting controls, which may lead to inaccurate financial statements, hampering shareholders’ ability to make informed investment decisions, and may lead to destruction of public confidence and shareholder value. The Audit Committee is ultimately responsible for the integrity and reliability of the company’s financial information and its system of internal controls.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from Audit Committee members under certain circumstances when a material weakness rises to a level of serious concern, if there are chronic internal control issues, or if there is an absence of established effective control mechanisms;

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals to ratify auditors if there is reason to believe that the independent auditor has rendered an opinion which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

Adverse Opinions

An Adverse Opinion on the company’s financial statements is issued when the auditor determines that the financial statements are materially misstated and, when considered as a whole, do not conform to GAAP. It essentially states that the information contained is materially incorrect, unreliable, and inaccurate in order to assess the company’s financial position and results of operations.

Adverse opinions on companies’ financial statements are generally very rare because they essentially state that a significant portion of the financial statements are unreliable and the auditor had no choice but to issue an adverse opinion after a long process of seeking resolution with the company subjected to the audit.

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD votes from Audit Committee members if the company receives an Adverse Opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditors.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-174


Table of Contents

 

TAKEOVER DEFENSES

Poison Pills

Shareholder rights plans, typically known as poison pills, take the form of rights or warrants issued to shareholders and are triggered when a potential acquiring stockholder reaches a certain threshold of ownership. When triggered, poison pills generally allow shareholders to purchase shares from, or sell shares back to, the target company (“flip-in-pill”) and/or the potential acquirer (“flip-out-pill”) at a price far out of line with fair market value.

Depending on the type of pill, the triggering event can either transfer wealth from the target company or dilute the equity holdings of current shareholders. Poison pills insulate management from the threat of a change in control and provide the target board with veto power over takeover bids. Because poison pills greatly alter the balance of power between shareholders and management, shareholders should be allowed to make their own evaluation of such plans.

In evaluating management proposals on poison pills, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services consider the company’s rationale for adopting the pill and its existing governance structure in determining whether or not the pill appropriately serves in shareholders’ best interests. The rationale for adopting the pill should be thoroughly explained by the company. Additionally, we examine the company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, or any problematic governance concerns.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis shareholder proposals to redeem a company’s poison pill;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis management proposals to ratify a poison pill;

 

   

Vote AGAINST or WITHHOLD from any board where a dead-hand poison pill provision is in place. From a shareholder perspective, there is no justification for a dead-hand provision. Directors of companies with these lethal protective devices should be held fully accountable.

Net operating losses (NOL) pills, which are used to preserve a tax benefit (as opposed to traditional poison pills which are used as a takeover defense), typically have low triggers that some shareholders have difficulty supporting. This lack of support may have the effect of discouraging issuers from seeking shareholder approval for such pills. In assessing NOL pills, we take into account the unique purpose and features of NOL pills to enable shareholders make informed decisions when presented with proposals to adopt such pills, and to encourage issuers to submit such pills to a shareholder vote.

For management proposals to adopt a poison pill for the stated purpose of preserving a company’s net operating losses (“NOL pills”), the following factors are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE following basis:

 

   

The ownership threshold to transfer (NOL pills generally have a trigger slightly below 5%);

 

   

The value of the NOLs;

 

   

The term;

 

   

Shareholder protection mechanisms (sunset provision, or commitment to cause expiration of the pill upon exhaustion or expiration of NOLs);

 

   

The company’s existing governance structure including: board independence, existing takeover defenses, track record of responsiveness to shareholders, and any other problematic governance concerns; and

 

   

Any other factors that may be applicable.

 

B-175


Table of Contents

 

Greenmail

Greenmail payments are targeted share repurchases by management of company stock from individuals or groups seeking control of the company. Since only the hostile party receives payment, usually at a substantial premium over the market value of shares, the practice discriminates against most shareholders. This transferred cash, absent the greenmail payment, could be put to much better use for reinvestment in the company, payment of dividends, or to fund a public share repurchase program.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to adopt an anti-greenmail provision in their charter or bylaws that would thereby restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments to certain shareholders;

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all anti-greenmail proposals when they are presented as bundled items with other charter or bylaw amendments.

Shareholder Ability to Remove Directors

Shareholder ability to remove directors, with or without cause, is either prescribed by a state’s business corporation law, individual company’s articles of incorporation, or its corporate bylaws. Many companies have sought shareholder approval for charter or bylaw amendments that would prohibit the removal of directors except for cause, thus ensuring that directors would retain their directorship for their full-term unless found guilty of self-dealing. By requiring cause to be demonstrated through due process, management insulates the directors from removal even if a director has been performing poorly, not attending meetings, or not acting in the best interests of shareholders.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals which seek to restore the authority of shareholders to remove directors with or without cause;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

Shareholder Ability to Alter the Size of the Board

Proposals that would allow management to increase or decrease the size of the board at its own discretion are often used by companies as a takeover defense. Proposals to fix the size of the board at a specific number can prevent management from increasing the board size without shareholder approval when facing a proxy context. By increasing the size of the board, management can make it more difficult for dissidents to gain control of the board. Fixing the size of the board also prevents a reduction in the size of the board as a strategy to oust independent directors. Fixing board size also prevents management from increasing the number of directors in order to dilute the effects of cumulative voting.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that seek to fix the size of the board within an acceptable range;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board without shareholder approval.

SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS

Confidential Voting

The confidential ballot ensures that voters are not subject to real or perceived coercion. In an open voting system, management can determine who has voted against its nominees or proposals before a final vote count. As a result, shareholders can be pressured to vote with management at companies with which they maintain or would like to establish a business relationship.

 

B-176


Table of Contents

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that request corporations to adopt confidential voting, the use of independent tabulators, and the use of independent inspectors for an election as long as the proposals include clauses for proxy contests. In the case of a contested election, management is permitted to request that the dissident group honor its confidential voting policy. If the dissidents agree, the policy remains in place. If the dissidents do not agree, the confidential voting policy is waived;

 

   

Vote FOR management proposals to adopt confidential voting procedures.

Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

Most state corporation statutes allow shareholders to call a special meeting when they want to take action on certain matters that arise between regularly scheduled annual meetings. Sometimes this right applies only if a shareholder or a group of shareholders own a specified percentage of shares, with ten percent being the most common. Shareholders may lose the ability to remove directors, initiate a shareholder resolution, or respond to a beneficial offer without having to wait for the next scheduled meeting if they are unable to act at a special meeting of their own calling.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to call special meetings;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals that remove restrictions on the right of shareholders to act independently of management;

 

   

Vote AGAINST provisions that would require advance notice of more than sixty days.

Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

Consent solicitations allow shareholders to vote on and respond to shareholder and management proposals by mail without having to act at a physical meeting. A consent card is sent by mail for shareholder approval and only requires a signature for action. Some corporate bylaws require supermajority votes for consents, while at others standard annual meeting rules apply. Shareholders may lose the ability to remove directors, initiate a shareholder resolution, or respond to a beneficial offer without having to wait for the next scheduled meeting if they are unable to act at a special meeting of their own calling.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to take action by written consent;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to allow or make easier shareholder action by written consent.

Unequal Voting Rights

Incumbent managers are able to use unequal voting rights through the creation of a separate class of shares that has superior voting rights to the common shares of regular shareholders. This separate class of shares with disproportionate voting power allows management to concentrate its power and insulate itself from the wishes of the majority of shareholders. Dual class exchange offers involve a transfer of voting rights from one group of shareholders to another group of shareholders typically through the payment of a preferential dividend. A dual class recapitalization plan also establishes two classes of common stock with unequal voting rights, but initially involves an equal distribution of preferential and inferior voting shares to current shareholders.

 

   

Vote FOR resolutions that seek to maintain or convert to a one-share-one-vote capital structure;

 

   

Vote AGAINST requests for the creation or continuation of dual class capital structures or the creation of new or additional super-voting shares.

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Amend the Charter or Bylaws

Supermajority shareholder vote requirements for charter or bylaw amendments are often the result of “lock-in” votes, which are the votes required to repeal new provisions to the corporate charter. Supermajority

 

B-177


Table of Contents

provisions violate the principle that a simple majority of voting shares should be all that is necessary to effect change regarding a company and its corporate governance provisions. Requiring more than this may entrench managers by blocking actions that are in the best interests of shareholders.

The general lack of credit availability for financially distressed companies has resulted in “rescue” or highly dilutive stock and warrant issuances, which often comprise a majority of the company’s voting stock upon conversion. When an investor takes control of the company through the conversion of securities, the new owners often seek statutory amendments, such as adopting written consent, or allowing 50 percent shareholders to call a special meeting, that allow effective control over the company with little or no input from minority shareholders.

In such cases, the existing supermajority vote requirements would serve to protect minority shareholders’ interests. The reduction in the vote requirements, when coupled with low quorum requirements (in Nevada and other states) could shift the balance in power away from small shareholders while overly empowering large shareholders.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve charter and bylaw amendments;

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals seeking to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements when they accompany management sponsored proposals to also change certain charter or bylaw amendments;

 

   

Vote FOR management or shareholder proposals to reduce supermajority vote requirements for charter and bylaw amendments. However, for companies with shareholder(s) who have significant ownership levels, vote CASE-BY-CASE, taking into account i) ownership structure, ii) quorum requirements, and iii) supermajority vote requirements.

Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Approve Mergers

Supermajority provisions violate the principle that a simple majority of voting shares should be all that is necessary to effect change regarding a company and its corporate governance provisions. Requiring more than this may entrench managers by blocking actions that are in the best interests of shareholders.

 

   

Vote AGAINST management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve mergers and other significant business combinations;

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements for mergers and other significant business combinations.

Reimbursing Proxy Solicitation Expenses

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals to reimburse for proxy solicitation expenses;

 

   

When voting in conjunction with support of a dissident slate, always support the reimbursement of all appropriate proxy solicitation expenses associated with the election;

 

   

Generally support requests seeking to reimburse a shareholder proponent for all reasonable campaign expenditures for a proposal approved by the majority of shareholders.

Bundled Proposals

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on bundled or conditional proxy proposals. In the case of items that are conditioned upon each other, examine the benefits and costs of the packaged items. In instances when the joint effect of the conditioned items is not in shareholders’ best interests, vote AGAINST the proposals. If the combined effect is positive, support such proposals.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-178


Table of Contents

 

MERGERS & ACQUISITIONS/CORPORATE RESTRUCTURINGS

A number of academic and industry studies in recent years have estimated that nearly three quarters of all corporate acquisitions fail to create economically meaningful shareholder value. These studies have also demonstrated that the larger the deal the greater the risk in realizing long-term value for shareholders of the acquiring firm. These risks include integration challenges, over-estimation of expected synergies, incompatible corporate cultures and poor succession planning. Indeed, some studies have found that smaller deals within specialized industries on average outperform “big bet” larger deals by a statistically significant factor.

In analyzing M&A deals, private placements or other transactional related items on proxy, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services performs a well-rounded analysis that seeks to balance all facets of the deal to ascertain whether the proposed acquisition is truly going to generate long-term value for shareholders and enhance the prospects of the ongoing corporation.

Votes on mergers and acquisitions are always considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Impact of the merger on shareholder value;

 

   

Perspective of ownership (target vs. acquirer) in the deal;

 

   

Form and mix of payment (i.e. stock, cash, debt, etc.);

 

   

Fundamental value drivers behind the deal;

 

   

Anticipated financial and operating benefits realizable through combined synergies;

 

   

Offer price (cost vs. premium);

 

   

Change-in-control payments to executive officers;

 

   

Financial viability of the combined companies as a single entity;

 

   

Was the deal put together in good faith? What kind of auction setting took place? Were negotiations carried out at arm’s length? Was any portion of the process tainted by possible conflicts of interest?;

 

   

Fairness opinion (or lack thereof);

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights;

 

   

What are the potential legal or environmental liability risks associated with the target firm?;

 

   

Impact on community stakeholders and employees in both workforces;

 

   

How will the merger adversely affect employee benefits like pensions and health care?

Fair Price Provisions

Fair price provisions were originally designed to specifically defend against the most coercive of takeover devises- the two-tiered, front-end loaded tender offer. In such a hostile takeover, the bidder offers cash for enough shares to gain control of the target. At the same time, the acquirer states that once control has been obtained, the target’s remaining shares will be purchased with cash, cash and securities, or only securities. Since the payment offered for the remaining stock is, by design, less valuable than the original offer for the controlling shares, shareholders are forced to sell out early to maximize the value of their shares. Standard fair price provisions require that in the absence of board or shareholder approval of the acquisition the bidder must pay the remaining shareholders the same price for their shares that brought control.

 

   

Vote FOR fair price proposals as long as the shareholder vote requirement embedded in the provision is no more than a majority of disinterested shares;

 

B-179


Table of Contents

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to lower the shareholder vote requirement in existing fair price provisions.

Corporate Restructuring

 

   

Votes concerning corporate restructuring proposals, including minority squeeze outs, leveraged buyouts, spin-offs, liquidations, and asset sales, are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Appraisal Rights

Rights of appraisal provide shareholders who do not approve of the terms of certain corporate transactions the right to demand a judicial review in order to determine the fair value for their shares. The right of appraisal applies to mergers, sale of corporate assets, and charter amendments that may have a materially adverse effect on the rights of dissenting shareholders.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to restore or provide shareholders with the right of appraisal.

Spin-offs

 

   

Votes on spin-offs are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis depending on the tax and regulatory advantages, planned use of sale proceeds, market focus, and managerial incentives.

Asset Sales

 

   

Votes on asset sales are made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis after considering the impact on the balance sheet/working capital, value received for the asset, and potential elimination of diseconomies.

Liquidations

 

   

Votes on liquidations are made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis after reviewing management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives, appraisal value of assets, and the compensation plan for executives managing the liquidation.

Going Private Transactions (LBOs, Minority Squeezeouts)

 

   

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on going private transactions, taking into account the following: offer price/premium, fairness opinion, how the deal was negotiated, conflicts of interest, other alternatives/offers considered, and non-completion risk.

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on “going dark” transactions, determining whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by taking into consideration whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly-traded (examination of trading volume, liquidity, and market research of the stock), cash-out value, whether the interests of continuing and cashed-out shareholders are balanced, and market reaction to public announcement of transaction.

Changing Corporate Name

 

   

Vote FOR changing the corporate name in all instances if proposed and supported by management and the board.

Plans of Reorganization (Bankruptcy)

The recent financial crisis has placed Chapter 11 bankruptcy reorganizations as a potential alternative for distressed companies. While the number of bankruptcies has risen over the past year as evidenced by many firms,

 

B-180


Table of Contents

including General Motors and Lehman Brothers, the prevalence of these reorganizations can vary year over year due to, among other things, market conditions and a company’s ability to sustain its operations. Additionally, the amount of time that lapses between a particular company’s entrance into Chapter 11 and its submission of a plan of reorganization varies significantly depending on the complexity, timing, and jurisdiction of the particular case. These plans are often put to a vote of shareholders (in addition to other interested parties), as required by the Bankruptcy Code.

 

   

Vote CASE-BY-CASE basis on proposals to common shareholders on bankruptcy plans of reorganization, considering the following factors including, but not limited to:

 

   

Estimated value and financial prospects of the reorganized company;

 

   

Percentage ownership of current shareholders in the reorganized company;

 

   

Whether shareholders are adequately represented in the reorganization process (particularly through the existence of an Official Equity Committee);

 

   

The cause(s) of the bankruptcy filing, and the extent to which the plan of reorganization addresses the cause(s); Existence of a superior alternative to the plan of reorganization; and Governance of the reorganized company.

 

B-181


Table of Contents

 

CAPITAL STRUCTURE

The management of a corporation’s capital structure involves a number of important issues including dividend policy, types of assets, opportunities for growth, ability to finance new projects internally, and the cost of obtaining additional capital. Many financing decisions have a significant impact on shareholder value, particularly when they involve the issuance of additional common stock, preferred stock, or debt.

Common Stock Authorization

State statutes and stock exchanges require shareholder approval for increases in the number of common shares. Corporations increase their supply of common stock for a variety of ordinary business purposes: raising new capital, funding stock compensation programs, business acquisitions, implementation of stock splits, or payment of stock dividends.

Clear justification should accompany all management requests for shareholders approval of increases in authorized common stock. We support increases in authorized common stock to fund stock splits that are in shareholders’ interests. Consideration will be made on a case-by-case basis on proposals when the company intends to use the additional stock to implement a poison pill or other takeover defense. The amount of additional stock requested in comparison to the requests of the company’s peers as well as the company’s articulated reason for the increase must be evaluated.

 

   

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to increase the number of shares of common stock authorized for issue. The following factors will be considered:

 

   

Past Board Performance: i) the company’s use of authorized shares during the last three years; ii) one- and three-year total shareholder return; and practices iii) the board’s governance structure and practices including existing takeover defenses and presence of egregious equity compensation practices;

 

   

The Current Request: i) specific reasons/rationale for the proposed increase; ii) the dilutive impact of the request; and iii) risks to shareholders of not approving the request.

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals at companies with dual-class capital structures to increase the number of authorized shares of the class of stock that has superior voting rights;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposed common stock authorizations that increase the existing authorization by more than fifty percent unless a clear need for the excess shares is presented by the company.

Reverse Stock Splits

Reverse splits exchange multiple shares for a lesser amount to increase share price. Increasing share price is sometimes necessary to restore a company’s share price to a level that will allow it to be traded on the national stock exchanges. In addition, some brokerage houses have a policy of not monitoring or investing in very low priced shares. Reverse stock splits can help maintain stock liquidity.

Management proposals to implement a reverse stock split will be reviewed on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into account whether there is a corresponding proportional decrease in authorized shares. Generally support a reverse stock split if management provides a reasonable justification for the split and reduces authorized shares accordingly. Without a corresponding decrease, a reverse stock split is effectively an increase in authorized shares by reducing the number of shares outstanding while leaving the number of authorized shares to be issued at the pre-split level.

Blank Check Preferred Authorization

Preferred stock is an equity security which has certain features similar to debt instruments- such as fixed dividend payments and seniority of claims to common stock — and usually carries little to no voting rights. The

 

B-182


Table of Contents

terms of blank check preferred stock give the board of directors the power to issue shares of preferred stock at their discretion with voting, conversion, distribution, and other rights to be determined by the board at time of issue. Blank check preferred stock can be used for sound corporate purposes but can also be used as a device to thwart hostile takeovers without shareholder approval.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to create “declawed” blank check preferred stock (stock that cannot be used as a takeover defense);

 

   

Vote FOR requests to require shareholder approval for blank check authorizations;

 

   

Vote FOR proposals to authorize preferred stock in cases where the company specifies the voting, dividend, conversion, and other rights of such stock and the terms of the preferred stock appear reasonable;

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals that would authorize the creation of new classes of preferred stock with unspecified voting, conversion, dividend, distribution, and other rights (“blank check” preferred stock);

 

   

Vote AGAINST proposals to increase the number of blank check preferred stock authorized for issuance when no shares have been issued or reserved for a specific purpose.

Adjust Par Value of Common Stock

Stock that has a fixed per share value that is on its certificate is called par value stock. The purpose of par value stock is to establish the maximum responsibility of a stockholder in the event that a corporation becomes insolvent. Proposals to reduce par value come from certain state level requirements for regulatory industries such as banks and other legal requirements relating to the payment of dividends.

 

   

Vote FOR management proposals to reduce the par value of common stock.

Preemptive Rights

Preemptive rights permit shareholders to share proportionately in any new issues of stock of the same class. These rights guarantee existing shareholders the first opportunity to purchase shares of new issues of stock in the same class as their own and in the same proportion. The absence of these rights could cause stockholders’ interest in a company to be reduced by the sale of additional shares without their knowledge and at prices unfavorable to them. Preemptive rights, however, can make it difficult for corporations to issue large blocks of stock for general corporate purposes. Both corporations and shareholders benefit when corporations are able to arrange issues without preemptive rights that do not result in a substantial transfer of control.

 

   

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to create or abolish preemptive rights. In evaluating proposals on preemptive rights, we look at the size of a company and the characteristics of its shareholder base.

Debt Restructuring

We review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to increase common and/or preferred shares and to issue shares as part of a debt-restructuring plan. The following factors are considered:

 

   

Dilution — How much will the ownership interest of existing shareholders be reduced, and how extreme will dilution to any future earnings be?

 

   

Change in Control — Will the transaction result in a change in control of the company? Are board and committee seats guaranteed? Do standstill provisions and voting agreements exist?

 

   

Financial Issues — company’s financial situation, degree of need for capital, use of proceeds, and effect of the financing on the company’s cost of capital

 

B-183


Table of Contents

 

   

Terms of the offer — discount/premium in purchase price to investor including any fairness opinion,

 

   

termination penalties and exit strategy

 

   

Conflict of interest — arm’s length transactions and managerial incentives

 

   

Management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals regarding debt restructurings.

Vote FOR the debt restructuring if it is expected that the company will file for bankruptcy if the transaction is not approved.

[this part of page intentionally left blank]

 

B-184


Table of Contents

 

STATE OF INCORPORATION

Voting on State Takeover Statutes

Review on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to opt in or out of state takeover statutes (including control share acquisition statutes, control share cash-out statutes, freeze out provisions, fair price provisions, stakeholder laws, poison pill endorsements, severance pay and labor contract provisions, anti-greenmail provisions, and disgorgement provisions). We generally support opting into stakeholder protection statutes if they provide comprehensive protections for employees and community stakeholders. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is less supportive of takeover statutes that only serve to protect incumbent management from accountability to shareholders and which negatively influence shareholder value.

Reincorporations Proposals

Management or shareholder proposals to change a company’s state of incorporation should be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, giving consideration to both financial and corporate governance concerns including the following:

 

   

Reasons for reincorporation;

 

   

Comparison of company’s governance practices and provisions prior to and following the reincorporation; and

 

   

Comparison of corporation laws of original state and destination state

Vote FOR reincorporation when the economic factors outweigh any neutral or negative governance changes.

Offshore Reincorporations and Tax Havens

For a company that seeks to reincorporate, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services evaluates the merits of the move on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into consideration the company’s strategic rationale for the move, the potential economic ramifications, potential tax benefits, and any corporate governance changes that may impact shareholders. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes there are a number of concerns associated with a company looking to reincorporate from the United States to offshore locales such as Bermuda, the Cayman Islands or Panama. The trend of U.S. companies seeking to move offshore appears to be on the rise, and shareholders are just beginning to understand the web of complexities surrounding the legal, tax, and governance implications involved in such a transaction.

When reviewing a proposed offshore move, the following factors are considered:

 

   

Legal recourse for U.S. stockholders of the new company and the enforcement of legal judgments against the company under the U.S. securities laws;

 

   

The transparency (or lack thereof) of the new locale’s legal system;

 

   

Adoption of any shareholder-unfriendly corporate law provisions;

 

   

Actual, quantifiable tax benefits associated with foreign incorporation;

 

   

Potential for accounting manipulations and/or discrepancies;

 

   

Any pending U.S. legislation concerning offshore companies;

 

   

Prospects of reputational harm and potential damage to brand name via increased media coverage concerning corporate expatriation.

Furthermore, generally support shareholder requests calling for “expatriate” companies that are domiciled abroad yet predominantly owned and operated in America to re-domesticate back to a U.S. state jurisdiction.

 

B-185


Table of Contents

 

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY & ACCOUNTABILITY

Social, Environmental and Sustainability Issues

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports social, workforce, and environmental shareholder-sponsored resolutions if they seek to create responsible corporate citizens while at the same time attempting to enhance long-term shareholder value. We typically support proposals that ask for disclosure reporting of information that is not available outside the company that is not proprietary in nature. Such reporting is particularly most vital when it appears that a company has not adequately addressed shareholder concerns regarding social, workplace, environmental and/or other issues. A determination whether the request is relevant to the company’s core business and in-line with industry practice will be made on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. The proponent of the resolution must make the case that the benefits of additional disclosure outweigh the costs of producing the report.

In determining our vote on social, workplace, environmental, and other related proposals, we specifically analyze the following factors:

 

   

Whether adoption of the proposal would have either a positive or negative impact on the company’s short-term or long-term share value;

 

   

Percentage of sales, assets, and earnings affected;

 

   

Degree to which the company’s stated position on the issues could affect its reputation or sales, or leave it vulnerable to boycott or selective purchasing;

 

   

Whether the issues presented should be dealt with through government or company-specific action;

 

   

Whether the company has already responded in some appropriate manner to the request embodied in a proposal;

 

   

Whether the company’s analysis and voting recommendation to shareholders is persuasive;

 

   

What its industry peers have done in response to the issue;

 

   

Whether the proposal itself is well framed and reasonable;

 

   

Whether implementation of the proposal would achieve the objectives sought in the proposal;

 

   

Whether the subject of the proposal is best left to the discretion of the board.

In general, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that request the company to furnish information helpful to shareholders in evaluating the company’s operations from top to bottom. In order to be able to intelligently monitor their investments, shareholders often need information that is best provided by the company in which they have invested on behalf of their end beneficiaries. Qualified requests satisfying the aforementioned criteria usually merit support.

Proposals requesting that the company cease certain actions that the proponent believes are harmful to society or some segment of society will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. Special attention will be made to the company’s legal and ethical obligations, its ability to remain profitable, and potential negative publicity if the company fails to honor the request. A high standard will need to be met by proponents requesting specific action like divesture of a business line or operation, legal remuneration, or withdrawal from certain high-risk markets.

 

B-186


Table of Contents

 

I. GENERAL CSR RELATED

Special Policy Review and Shareholder Advisory Committees

These resolutions propose the establishment of special committees of the board to address broad corporate policy and provide forums for ongoing dialogue on issues including, but not limited to: shareholder relations, the environment, occupational health and safety, and executive compensation.

 

   

Support these proposals when they appear to offer a potentially effective method for enhancing shareholder value.

Operations in Protected or Sensitive Areas

Operating in regions protected or established under national or international categorization guidelines, including wildlife refuges, national forests, and IUCN categorized areas expose companies to increased oversight and the potential for associated risk and controversy. While it is important for a company to have the flexibility to operate in these regions to take advantage of strategic placement or growth, additional disclosure could be an important mitigating factor when addressing increased risk and oversight. Restrictions to the company’s operations, damaging public opinion, and costly litigation resulting from failure to comply with the requirements associated with protected or categorized regions could have a significant impact on shareholder value.

 

   

Generally support shareholder requests for reports outlining potential environmental damage from operations in protected regions, including wildlife refuges, unless the company does not currently have operations or plans to develop operations in these protected regions.

Land Use

Many large retail stores and real estate development firms have received criticism over their policies and processes for acquiring and developing land. Often, in such cases, there are organizations that support as well as those that oppose the proposed development.

Many of these requests brought forth by the respective stakeholders raise serious issues that can have a real impact on short-term shareholder value. However in some cases, additional reporting may be duplicative of existing disclosure or may fail to provide added benefit to shareholders commensurate with the associated cost or burden of providing additional information. Some of the companies targeted with this resolution have been subject to recent litigation and/or significant fines stemming from its land use practices or recent community boycotts.

 

   

Generally support shareholder resolutions that request better disclosure of detailed information on a company’s policies related to land use or development or compliance with local and national laws and zoning requirements.

International Financial Related

The rise of globalization has put increasing importance on the need for US companies to periodically monitor their business operations abroad. As a means to preserve brand integrity and protect against potentially costly litigation and negative public relations, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports shareholder proposals which call for a report on the company’s core business policies and procedures of its operations outside the United States.

Many of the resolutions which address a company’s international policies can include: impact of Foreign Direct Investment (FDI) in emerging market economies; corporate safeguards against money laundering; terrorist financing; economic de-stabilization concerns; relationships with international financial institutions (IFIs); and product sales/marketing abroad (i.e., tobacco, pharmaceutical drug pricing).

 

B-187


Table of Contents

 

   

Generally support proposals asking for policy clarification and reporting on foreign-related matters that can materially impact the company’s short and long-term bottom line.

Affirm Political Non-Partisanship

Employees should not be put in a position where professional standing and goodwill within the corporation could be jeopardized as a result of political beliefs. Responsible employment practices should protect workers from an environment characterized by political indoctrination or intimidation. Corporations should not devote resources to partisan political activities, nor should they compel their employees to contribute to or support particular causes. Moreover, it is wise for a corporation to maintain a politically neutral stance as to avoid potentially embarrassing conflicts of interests that could negatively impact the company’s brand name with consumers.

 

   

Generally support proposals affirming political non-partisanship within the company.

Political Contributions Reporting & Disclosure

Changes in legislation that governs corporate political giving have, rather than limiting such contributions, increased the complexity of tracking how much money corporations contribute to the political process and where that money ultimately ends up. A company’s involvement in the political process could impact shareholder value if such activities are not properly overseen and managed.

Shareholders have the right to know about corporate political activities, and management’s knowledge that such information can be made publicly available should encourage a company’s lawful and responsible use of political contributions.

Moreover, it is critical that shareholders understand the internal controls that are in place at a company to adequately manage political contributions. Given the significant reputational and financial risk involved in political giving, shareholders should expect management to have the necessary capabilities to monitor and track all monies distributed toward political groups and causes. These internal controls should be fully consistent with Section 404 requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

While political contributions, lobbying and other corporate political activity can benefit the strategic interests of a company, it is important that accountability mechanisms are in place to ensure that monies disbursed in support of political objectives actually generate identifiable returns on shareholder wealth. Such mechanisms serve to insure against the use of shareholder funds in the furtherance of narrow management agendas.

When analyzing the proposals, special consideration will be made if the target company has been the subject of significant controversy stemming from its contributions or political activities, if the company fails to disclose a policy to shareholders that outlines the process by which the company considers its political contributions, or if the company has recently been involved in significant controversy or litigation related to the company’s political contributions or governmental affairs.

 

   

Support reporting of political and political action committee (PAC) contributions;

 

   

Support establishment of corporate political contributions guidelines and internal reporting provisions or controls;

 

   

Vote AGAINST shareholder proposals asking to publish in newspapers and public media the company’s political contributions as such publications could present significant cost to the company without providing commensurate value to shareholders.

 

B-188


Table of Contents

 

Military Sales

Shareholder proposals from church groups and other community organizations ask companies for detailed reports on foreign military sales. These proposals often can be created at reasonable cost to the company and contain no proprietary data. Large companies can supply this information without undue burden and provide shareholders with information affecting corporate performance and decision-making.

 

   

Generally support reports on foreign military sales and economic conversion of facilities and where such reporting will not disclose sensitive information that could impact the company adversely or increase its legal exposure;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals asking a company to develop specific military contracting criteria.

Report on Operations in Sensitive Regions or Countries

Over the past decade, a number of public companies — especially within the extractive sector — have withdrawn from geopolitically sensitive regions as a result of being associated with political controversies involving their host countries (i.e. Myanmar, the Sudan, China, Iran, etc.). Oil and natural gas companies, in particular, continue be the largest investors in many countries involved in human rights abuse and terrorist activities. As such, these companies become targets of consumer boycotts, public relations backlash and even governmental intervention.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals to adopt labor standards in connection with involvement in a certain market and other potentially sensitive geopolitical regions;

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking a report on operations within a certain market and documentation of costs of continued involvement in a given country or region;

 

   

Generally support requests for establishment of a board committee to review and report on the reputational risks and legal compliance with U.S. sanctions as a result of the company’s continued operations in countries associated with terrorist sponsored activities;

 

   

Consider shareholder proposals to pull out of a certain market on a CASE-BY-CASE basis considering factors such as overall cost, FDI exposure, level of disclosure for investors, magnitude of controversy, and the current business focus of the company.

Recycling Policy

A number of companies have received proposals to step-up their recycling efforts, with the goal of reducing the company’s negative impact on the environment and reducing costs over the long-term.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that ask companies to increase their recycling efforts or to adopt a formal recycling policy.

II. CLIMATE CHANGE ~ GLOBAL WARMING

Shareholder proposals addressing environmental and energy concerns have been plentiful in recent years, and generally seek greater disclosure on an issue or seek to improve a company’s environmental practices in order to protect the world’s natural resources. In addition, some proponents cite the negative financial implications for companies with poor environmental practices, including liabilities associated with site clean-ups and lawsuits, as well as arguments that energy efficient products and clean environmental practices are sustainable business practices that will contribute to long-term shareholder value. Shareholders say the majority of independent atmospheric scientists agree that global warming poses a serious problem to the health and welfare of all countries, citing the findings of the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC), the world’s most authoritative scientific body on the subject. Shareholder proponents argue that companies can report on their greenhouse gas emissions within a few months at reasonable cost.

 

B-189


Table of Contents

 

Kyoto Compliance

The Kyoto Protocol was officially ratified in November 2004 and requires the reduction of greenhouse gas emissions by signatory countries in an effort to lower the global emissions of six key greenhouse gasses and address concerns over climate change. While some Kyoto signatory markets have not yet released the details of their respective regulations for companies, it is clear that there will be some significant financial impact on corporate issuers, especially those that operate in industries profoundly impacted by greenhouse gas emission constraints or regulation. In order to comply with the anticipated standards, companies will have to consider options such as: capital improvement to their facilities to reduce emissions, the cost of “trading” carbon credits on an open market to offset emission overages, or the expense of fines or restrictions resulting from noncompliance.

 

   

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports resolutions requesting that companies outline their preparations to comply with standards established by Kyoto Protocol signatory markets, unless: 1) The company does not maintain operations in Kyoto signatory markets; or 2) The company already evaluates and substantially discloses such information to shareholders; or, 3) Greenhouse gas emissions do not materially impact the company’s core businesses.

Greenhouse Gas Emissions

Scientists generally agree that gases released by chemical reactions including the burning of fossil fuels contribute to a “greenhouse effect” that traps the planet’s heat. Environmentalists claim that the greenhouse gases produced by the industrial age have caused recent weather crises such as heat waves, rainstorms, melting glaciers, rising sea levels and receding coastlines. With notable exceptions, business leaders have described the rise and fall of global temperatures as naturally occurring phenomena and depicted corporate impact on climate change as minimal.

Shareholder proposals asking a company to issue a report to shareholders — at reasonable cost and omitting proprietary information — on greenhouse gas emissions ask that the report include descriptions of efforts within companies to reduce emissions, their financial exposure and potential liability from operations that contribute to global warming, and their direct or indirect efforts to promote the view that global warming is not a threat. Proponents argue that there is scientific proof that the burning of fossil fuels causes global warming, that future legislation may make companies financially liable for their contributions to global warming, and that a report on the company’s role in global warming can be assembled at reasonable cost.

Investment in Renewable Energy

Filers of proposals on renewable energy ask companies to increase their investment in renewable energy sources and to work to develop products that rely more on renewable energy sources. Increased use of renewable energy will reduce the negative environmental impact of energy companies. In addition, as supplies of oil and coal exist in the earth in limited quantities, renewable energy sources represent a competitive, and some would even argue essential, long-term business strategy.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking increased investment in renewable energy sources, taking into account whether the terms of the resolution are realistic or overly restrictive for management to pursue.

 

   

Generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for a company to commit to reducing its greenhouse gas emissions under a reasonable timeline.

Sustainability Reporting and Planning

The concept of sustainability is commonly understood as meeting the needs of the present generation without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. Indeed, the term sustainability is

 

B-190


Table of Contents

complex and poses significant challenges for companies on many levels. Many in the investment community have termed this broader responsibility the “triple bottom line,” referring to the triad of performance goals related to economic prosperity, social responsibility and environmental quality. In essence, the concept requires companies to balance the needs and interests of their various stakeholders while operating in a manner that sustains business growth for the long-term, supports local communities and protects the environment and natural capital for future generations.

Reporting and enhanced disclosure addressing sustainable development is important to companies namely because it offers a formal structure for decision making that helps management teams anticipate and address important global trends that can have serious consequences for business and society. Shareholders may request general sustainability reports on a specific location (i.e. drilling in ANWR) or operation (i.e. nuclear facility), often requesting that the company detail the environmental, social, legal and other risks and/or potential liabilities of the specific project in question.

A number of companies have begun to report on sustainability issues using established standards in the marketplace. Such reporting focuses on corporate compliance and measurement regarding key economic, environmental, and social performance indicators. Many best practice companies release annual sustainability reports in conjunction to regular annual statement of operations.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals seeking greater disclosure on the company’s environmental practices, and/or environmental risks and liabilities.

Endorsement of CERES Principles

These resolutions call for the adoption of principles that encourage the company to protect the environment and the safety and health of its employees. The CERES Principles, formulated by the Coalition of Environmentally Responsible Economies, require signing companies to address environmental issues, including protection of the biosphere, sustainable use of natural resources, reduction and disposal of wastes, energy conservation, and employee and community risk reduction. A signee to the CERES Principles would disclose its efforts in such areas through a standardized report submitted to CERES and made available to the public.

Evidence suggests that environmentally conscious companies may realize long-term savings by implementing programs to pollute less and conserve resources. In addition, environmentally responsible companies stand to benefit from good public relations and new marketing opportunities. Moreover, the reports that are required of signing companies provide shareholders with more information concerning topics they may deem relevant to their company’s financial well-being. Roughly thirty public companies have voluntarily adopted these principles.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that improve a company’s public image, reduce exposure to liabilities, and establish standards so that environmentally responsible companies and markets are not at a competitive financial disadvantage.

 

   

Vote FOR requests asking a company to formally adopt the CERES Principles;

 

   

Vote FOR adoption of reports to shareholders on environmental issues.

III. WORKPLACE PRACTICES  & HUMAN RIGHTS

Equal Employment Opportunity

These proposals generally request that a company establish a policy of reporting to shareholders its progress with equal opportunity and affirmative action programs. The costs of violating federal laws that prohibit discrimination by corporations are high and can affect corporate earnings.

 

B-191


Table of Contents

 

The Equal Opportunities Employment Commission (EEOC) does not release the company’s filings to the public unless it is involved in litigation, and it is difficult to obtain from other sources. Companies need to be very sensitive to minority employment issues as the new evolving work force becomes increasingly diverse. This information can be provided with little cost to the company and does not create an unreasonable burden on management.

 

   

Vote FOR proposals calling for action on equal employment opportunity and anti-discrimination;

 

   

Vote FOR legal and regulatory compliance and public reporting related to non-discrimination, affirmative action, workplace health and safety, environmental issues, and labor policies and practices that affect long-term corporate performance;

 

   

Vote FOR non-discrimination in salary, wages, and all benefits.

High-Performance Workplace

High-performance workplace practices emphasize employee training, participation, and feedback. The concept of a high-performance workplace has been endorsed by the U.S. Department of Labor and refers to a workplace that is designed to provide workers with the information, skills, incentives, and responsibility to make decisions essential for innovation, quality improvement and rapid response to changes in the marketplace. These standards embrace a “what is good for the worker is good for the company” philosophy. Studies have shown that improvement in human resources practices is associated with increases in total return to shareholders. High-performance workplace standards proposals can include linking compensation to social measures such as employee training, morale and safety, environmental performance and workplace lawsuits.

 

   

Generally support proposals that incorporate high-performance workplace standards.

Non-Discrimination in Retirement Benefits

A cash balance plan is a defined benefit plan that treats an earned retirement benefit as if it were a credit from a defined contribution plan, but which provides a stated benefit at the end of its term. Because employer contributions to these plans are credited evenly over the life of a plan and not based on a seniority formula, they may reduce payouts to long-term employees who are currently vested in plans.

Cash-balance pension conversions have undergone significant congressional and federal agency scrutiny in the wake of high-profile EEOC complaints on age discrimination and employee anger at several large blue-chip companies. While significant policy reform is unlikely in the short-term, business interests are worried enough that the National Association of Manufacturers and other pro-business lobbies have formed a coalition on Capitol Hill to preserve the essential features of the plans and to overturn a recent IRS ruling.

Driving the push behind conversions from traditional pension plans to cash-balance plans are the substantial savings that companies generate in the process. Critics point out that this savings is gained at the expense of the most senior employees. Shareholder resolutions call on corporate boards to establish a committee of outside directors to prepare a report to shareholders on the potential impact of pension-related proposals now being considered by national policymakers in reaction to the controversy spawned by the plans.

 

   

Support proposals calling for a non-discrimination policy with regard to retirement benefits and pension management at a company.

Fair Lending Reporting and Compliance

These resolutions call for financial institutions to comply with fair lending laws and statutes while avoiding predatory practices in their sub-prime lending. These predatory practices include: lending to borrowers with inadequate income, who will then default; not reporting on payment performances of borrowers to credit agencies; implying that credit life insurance is necessary to obtain the loan (packing); unnecessarily high fees;

 

B-192


Table of Contents

refinancing with high additional fees rather than working out a loan that is in arrears (flipping); and high pre-payment fees.

 

   

Support proposals calling for full compliance with fair-lending laws;

 

   

Support reporting on overall lending policies and data.

MacBride Principles

These resolutions call for the adoption of the MacBride Principles for operations located in Northern Ireland. They request companies operating abroad to support the equal employment opportunity policies that apply in facilities they operate domestically. The principles were established to address the sectarian hiring problems between Protestants and Catholics in Northern Ireland. It is well documented that Northern Ireland’s Catholic community faces much higher unemployment figures than the Protestant community. In response to this problem, the U.K. government instituted the New Fair Employment Act of 1989 (and subsequent amendments) to address the sectarian hiring problems.

Many companies believe that the Act adequately addresses the problems and that further action, including adoption of the MacBride Principles, only duplicates the efforts already underway. In evaluating a proposal to adopt the MacBride Principles, shareholders must decide whether the principles will cause companies to divest, and therefore worsen the unemployment problem, or whether the principles will promote equal hiring practices. Proponents believe that the Fair Employment Act does not sufficiently address the sectarian hiring problems. They argue that the MacBride Principles will stabilize the situation and promote further investment.

 

   

Support the MacBride Principles for operations in Northern Ireland that request companies to abide by equal employment opportunity policies.

Contract Supplier Standards

These resolutions call for compliance with governmental mandates and corporate policies regarding nondiscrimination, affirmative action, work place safety and health, and other basic labor protections.

We generally support proposals that:

 

   

Seek publication of a “Worker Code of Conduct” to be implemented by the company’s foreign suppliers and licensees, requiring they satisfy all applicable labor standards and laws protecting employees’ wages, benefits, working conditions, freedom of association, right to collectively bargain, and other rights;

 

   

Request a report summarizing the company’s current practices for enforcement of its Worker Code of Conduct;

 

   

Establishes independent monitoring mechanism in conjunction with local and respected religious and human rights groups to monitor supplier and licensee compliance with the Worker Code of Conduct;

 

   

Create incentives to encourage suppliers to raise standards rather than terminate contracts;

 

   

Implement policies for ongoing wage adjustments, ensuring adequate purchasing power and a sustainable living wage for employees of foreign suppliers and licensees;

 

   

Request public disclosure of contract supplier reviews on a regular basis;

 

   

Adopt labor standards for foreign and domestic suppliers to ensure that the company will not do business with foreign suppliers that manufacture products for sale in the U.S. using forced or child labor, or that fail to comply with applicable laws protecting employees’ wages and working conditions.

 

B-193


Table of Contents

 

Corporate Conduct and Labor Code of Conduct

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports proposals that call for the adoption and/or enforcement of clear principles or codes of conduct relating to countries in which there are systematic violations of human rights. These conditions include the use of slave, child, or prison labor, undemocratically elected governments, widespread reports by human rights advocates, fervent pro-democracy protests, or economic sanctions and boycotts.

Many proposals refer to the seven core conventions, commonly referred to as the “Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights At Work,” ratified by the International Labor Organization (ILO). The seven conventions fall under four broad categories: i) right to organize and bargain collectively; ii) non-discrimination in employment; iii) abolition of forced labor; and iv) end of child labor. Each of the 180 member nations of the ILO body are bound to respect and promote these rights to the best of their abilities.

 

   

Support the principles and codes of conduct relating to company investment and/or operations in countries with patterns of human rights abuses or pertaining to geographic regions experiencing political turmoil (Northern Ireland, Columbia, Burma, former Soviet Union, and China);

 

   

Support the implementation and reporting on ILO codes of conduct;

 

   

Support independent monitoring programs in conjunction with local and respected religious and human rights groups to monitor supplier and licensee compliance with Codes.

IV CONSUMER HEALTH & PUBLIC SAFETY

Phase-out or Label Products Containing Genetically Engineered Ingredients

Shareholder activists request companies engaged in the development of genetically modified agricultural products (GMOs) to adopt a policy of not marketing or distributing such products until long term safety testing demonstrates that they are not harmful to humans, animals or the environment. Until further long term testing demonstrates that these products are not harmful, companies in the restaurant, prepared foods and packaging industries are being asked to remove genetically altered ingredients from products they manufacture, distribute or sell, and label such products in the interim. Shareholders are asking supermarket companies to do the same for their own private label brands.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals to label products that contain genetically engineered products;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals calling for a full phase out of product lines containing GMO ingredients.

Tobacco-Related Proposals

Shareholders file resolutions annually asking that companies with ties to the tobacco industry account for their marketing and distribution strategies, particularly as they impact smoking by young people. While the specific resolutions for shareholder proponents vary from year to year, activist shareholders consistently make the tobacco industry one of their most prominent targets. Examples of tobacco proposals include: attempting to link executive compensation with teen smoking rates; the placement of company tobacco products in retail outlets; the impact of second hand smoke; and a review of advertising campaigns and their impact on children and minority groups.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals seeking to limit the sale of tobacco products to minors;

 

   

Generally vote AGAINST proposals calling for a full phase out of tobacco related product lines.

Toxic Emissions

Shareholder proposals asking companies to take steps to minimize their emissions of toxic chemicals or release of toxic waster into the environment can vary greatly. Some focus on reporting on the impact of these

 

B-194


Table of Contents

chemicals on the communities in which the company operates. Still others ask for a review of the company’s efforts to minimize pollution.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals calling on the company to establish a plan reduce toxic emissions.

Toxic Chemicals

The use of toxic chemicals in cosmetics, consumables, and household products has become a growing issue of concern for shareholders as international regulations on this topic continue to expand, providing increased scrutiny over potentially toxic materials or compounds used or emitted in the conduct of operations or as an ingredient in consumer goods. Shareholders must recognize the impact that changing regulation and consumer expectations could have on shareholder value and should encourage companies to disclose their policies regarding the use or emission of toxic chemicals. Specific considerations should be made for a company’s geographic markets and the appearance of historical difficulties with controversy, fines, or litigation, requests for disclosure on the potential financial and legal risk associated with toxic chemicals.

 

   

Generally support resolutions requesting that a company discloses its policies related to toxic chemicals;

 

   

Generally support shareholder resolutions requesting that companies evaluate and disclose the potential financial and legal risks associated with utilizing certain chemicals;

Nuclear Safety

These resolutions are filed at companies that manage nuclear power facilities or produce components for nuclear reactors to request disclosure on the risks to the company associated with these operations, including physical security and the potential for environmental damage. Current reporting requirements for companies that operate nuclear facilities are managed by the Nuclear Regulatory Commission (NRC) and include detailed reports on safety and security that are available to the public.

 

   

Generally support shareholder resolutions requesting that companies report on risks associated with their nuclear reactor designs and/or the production and interim storage of irradiated fuel rods.

Concentrated Area Feeding Operations (CAFOs)

The level of pollution resulting from CAFOs has drawn increased attention in recent years as certain legal decisions have established the precedent that a company can be held liable for the actions of the contract farms it sources from. Fines and remediation expenses stemming from these cases have been significant and could have a notable impact on the companies’ operations and shareholder value.

 

   

Generally support resolutions requesting that companies report to shareholders on the risks and liabilities associated with concentrated animal feeding operations (CAFOs) unless the company has publicly disclosed guidelines for its corporate and contract farming operations, including compliance monitoring or if the company does not directly source from CAFOs.

Pharmaceutical Product Reimportation

One of the most visible aspects of the legal and political debate over rising health care costs in the United States can be seen through prescription drug reimportation through Canada. While U.S. and Canadian regulations limit reimportation, several states have taken steps to encourage employees to actively seek less expensive medications through reimportation.

Shareholder action at major pharmaceutical companies has requested increased disclosure of the financial and legal risks associated with company policies, or called on companies to change distribution limits to increase product availability in Canada, thereby encouraging product reimportation to the United States. The level of

 

B-195


Table of Contents

public concern over this issue and associated impact that a poorly developed policy could have on the companies suggest that additional disclosure of company policies related to reimportation could be beneficial to shareholders and generally merits support.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals requesting that companies report on the financial and legal impact of their policies regarding prescription drug reimportation, unless such information is already publicly disclosed.

 

   

Generally support shareholder proposals requesting that companies adopt specific policies to encourage or not constrain prescription drug reimportation.

Pharmaceutical Product Pricing

Pharmaceutical drug pricing, both within the United States and internationally, has raised many questions of the companies that are responsible for creating and marketing these treatments. Shareholder proponents, activists and even some legislators have called upon drug companies to restrain pricing of prescription drugs.

The high cost of prescription drugs is a vital issue for senior citizens across the country. Seniors have the greatest need for prescription drugs, accounting for about one-third of all prescription drug sales, but they often live on fixed incomes and are underinsured. Today about 20 million elderly people have little or no drug coverage in the U.S. In addition, the uninsured and underinsured pay substantially more for drugs than manufacturers favored customers such as HMOs and Federal agencies.

Proponents note that efforts to reign-in pharmaceutical costs will not negatively impact research and development (R&D) costs and that retail drug prices are consistently higher in the U.S. than in other industrialized nations. Pharmaceutical companies often respond that adopting a formal drug pricing policy could put the company at a competitive disadvantage.

Against the backdrop of the AIDS crisis in Africa, many shareholders have called on companies to address the issue of affordable drugs for the treatment of AIDS, as well as TB and Malaria throughout the developing world. When analyzing such resolutions, consideration should be made of the strategic implications of pricing policies in the market.

 

   

Proposals asking a company to implement price restraints on its pharmaceutical products will be evaluated on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, taking into account the following factors:

 

   

Whether the proposal focuses on a specific drug and region;

 

   

Whether the economic benefits of providing subsidized drugs (e.g., public goodwill) outweigh the costs in terms of reduced profits, lower R&D spending, and harm to competitiveness;

 

   

The extent that reduced prices can be offset through the company’s marketing expenditures without significantly impacting R&D spending;

 

   

Whether the company already limits price increases of its products;

 

   

Whether the company already contributes life-saving pharmaceuticals to the needy and Third World countries;

 

   

The extent to which peer companies implement price restraints.

 

   

Generally support proposals requesting that companies implement specific price restraints for its pharmaceutical products in developing markets or targeting certain population groups.

 

   

Generally support proposals requesting that the company evaluate their global product pricing strategy, considering the existing level of disclosure on pricing policies, any deviation from established industry pricing norms, and the company’s existing philanthropic initiatives.

 

   

Vote FOR shareholder proposals that call on companies to develop a policy to provide affordable HIV, AIDS, TB and Malaria drugs to citizens in the developing world.

 

B-196


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 

2010 Taft-Hartley International Proxy Voting Guidelines

January 2010

 

 

 

Copyright © 2010 by RiskMetrics Group.

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopy, recording, or any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. Requests for permission to make copies of any part of this work should be sent to: RiskMetrics Group Marketing Department, One Chase Manhattan Plaza, 44th Floor, New York, NY 10005. RiskMetrics Group is a trademark used herein under license.

Risk Management  |  RiskMetrics Labs  |  ISS Governance Services  |  Financial Research & Analysis

www.riskmetrics.com

 

B-197


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

  

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

     B-200   

FINANCIAL RESULTS/DIRECTOR AND AUDITOR REPORTS

     B-200   

APPOINTMENT OF AUDITORS AND AUDITOR COMPENSATION

     B-201   

Ratifying Auditors

     B-201   

APPOINTMENT OF INTERNAL STATUTORY AUDITORS

     B-202   

ALLOCATION OF INCOME

     B-202   

STOCK (SCRIP) DIVIDEND ALTERNATIVE AND DIVIDEND REINVESTMENT PLANS

     B-203   

AMENDMENTS TO ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

     B-203   

CHANGE IN COMPANY FISCAL TERM

     B-204   

LOWER DISCLOSURE THRESHOLD FOR STOCK OWNERSHIP

     B-204   

TRANSACT OTHER BUSINESS

     B-204   

DIRECTOR AND SUPERVISORY BOARD MEMBER ELECTIONS

     B-205   

CONTESTED DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

     B-208   

DIRECTOR FEES

     B-209   

DISCHARGE OF BOARD AND MANAGEMENT

     B-209   

DIRECTOR AND OFFICER LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION, AND AUDITOR INDEMNIFICATION

     B-210   

BOARD STRUCTURE

     B-211   

Board Size

     B-211   

Adopt Classified Board

     B-211   

Introduction of Mandatory Age of Retirement

     B-212   

Altering Board Size

     B-212   

CAPITAL SYSTEMS

     B-212   

Authorized Capital System

     B-212   

Conditional Capital System

     B-212   

SHARE ISSUANCE REQUESTS

     B-213   

General Issuances

     B-213   

Specific Issuances

     B-213   

INCREASES IN AUTHORIZED CAPITAL

     B-214   

REDUCTION OF CAPITAL

     B-214   

CAPITAL STRUCTURES

     B-215   

PREFERRED STOCK

     B-215   

BLANK CHECK PREFERRED STOCK

     B-216   

DEBT ISSUANCE REQUESTS

     B-217   

PLEDGING OF ASSETS FOR DEBT

     B-217   

INCREASE IN BORROWING POWERS

     B-217   

SHARE REPURCHASE PLANS

     B-218   

REISSUANCE OF SHARES REPURCHASED

     B-219   

CAPITALIZATION OF RESERVES FOR BONUS ISSUES/INCREASE IN PAR VALUE

     B-219   

REORGANIZATIONS/RESTRUCTURINGS

     B-220   

MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS

     B-220   

REINCORPORATION PROPOSALS

     B-222   

EXPANSION OF BUSINESS ACTIVITIES

     B-223   

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

     B-223   

COMPENSATION PLANS

     B-224   

Stock Option Plans

     B-225   

Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options Under the Plan

     B-226   

Exercise Price

     B-226   

Exercise Price Discounts

     B-226   

Plan Administration

     B-226   

Eligibility and Participation

     B-227   

 

B-198


Table of Contents

Performance Criteria and Vesting Provisions

     B-227   

Retesting of Performance Criteria

     B-227   

Other Features Specific to Option Plans

     B-227   

Issue Terms

     B-227   

Option Repricing

     B-227   

Financial Assistance

     B-227   

Plans for International Employees

     B-228   

Stock Appreciation Rights

     B-228   

Phantom Stock Option Plans

     B-228   

Super Options

     B-228   

Restricted Stock

     B-228   

Dividends Under Option and Dividend Equivalent Payment Provisions

     B-228   

Incentive Plans

     B-228   

Share Purchase Plans

     B-229   

Other Features Specific to Share Purchase Plans

     B-229   

Eligibility

     B-229   

Loan Terms

     B-229   

Grants Outside of Plans

     B-230   

ANTITAKEOVER MECHANISMS

     B-230   

Renew Partial Takeover Provision (Australia)

     B-230   

Golden Shares

     B-230   

Poison Pills (Canada)

     B-230   

Depositary Receipts and Priority Shares (The Netherlands)

     B-232   

SHAREHOLDER PROPOSALS

     B-232   

Corporate Governance Proposals

     B-233   

Social and Environmental Proposals

     B-233   

Report on Environmental Policies

     B-234   

Adoption of “CERES Principles”

     B-234   

Adoption of “MacBride Principles”

     B-234   

Contract Supplier Standards

     B-234   

Corporate Conduct and Human Rights

     B-234   

 

B-199


Table of Contents

 

TAFT-HARTLEY ADVISORY SERVICES

PROXY VOTING POLICY STATEMENT AND GUIDELINES

This statement sets forth the proxy voting policy of RiskMetrics’ Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote the proxies of its clients solely in the interest of their participants and beneficiaries and for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to them. The interests of participants and beneficiaries will not be subordinated to unrelated objectives. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall act with the care, skill, prudence, and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims. When proxies due to Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ clients have not been received, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will make reasonable efforts to obtain missing proxies. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is not responsible for voting proxies it does not receive.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall analyze each proxy on a case-by-case basis, informed by the guidelines elaborated below, subject to the requirement that all votes shall be cast solely in the long-term interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plans. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not intend for these guidelines to be exhaustive. Hundreds of issues appear on proxy ballots every year, and it is neither practical nor productive to fashion voting guidelines and policies which attempt to address every eventuality. Rather, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines are intended to cover the most significant and frequent proxy issues that arise across international markets. Issues not covered by the guidelines shall be voted in the interest of plan participants and beneficiaries of the plan based on a worker-owner view of long-term corporate value. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall revise its guidelines as events warrant.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall report annually to its clients on proxy votes cast on their behalf. These proxy voting reports will demonstrate Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ compliance with its responsibilities and will facilitate clients’ monitoring of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services. A copy of this Proxy Voting Policy Statement and Guidelines is provided to each client at the time Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is retained. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services shall provide its clients with revised copies of this proxy voting policy statement and guidelines whenever significant revisions have been made.

FINANCIAL RESULTS/DIRECTOR AND AUDITOR REPORTS

Vote FOR approval of financial statements and director and auditor reports, unless:

 

   

There are concerns about the accounts presented or audit procedures used; or

 

   

The company is not responsive to shareholder questions about specific items that should be publicly disclosed.

 

   

The company failed to disclose the financial reports in a timely manner.

Discussion

Most companies around the world submit these reports to shareholders for approval, and this is one of the first items on most agendas. The official financial statements and director and auditor reports are valuable documents when evaluating a company’s annual performance. The director report usually includes a review of the company’s performance during the year, justification of dividend levels and profits or losses, special events such as acquisitions or disposals, and future plans for the company.

The auditor report discloses any irregularities or problems with the company’s finances. While a qualified report by itself is not sufficient reason to oppose this resolution, it raises cautionary flags of which shareholders should be aware. Most auditor reports are unqualified, meaning that in the auditor’s opinion, the company’s financial statements are made in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

 

B-200


Table of Contents

When evaluating a company’s financial statements, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks at debt/equity levels on the balance sheet, historical sales and earnings performance, dividend history and payout ratios, and the company’s own performance relative to similar companies in its industry. Unless there are major concerns about the accuracy of the financial statements or the director or auditor reports, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally approves of this item.

APPOINTMENT OF AUDITORS AND AUDITOR COMPENSATION

Ratifying Auditors

Vote FOR the reelection of auditors and proposals authorizing the board to fix auditor fees, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the procedures used by the auditor;

 

   

There is reason to believe that the auditor has rendered an opinion, which is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position;

 

   

External auditors have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company;

 

   

Name of the proposed auditors has not been published;

 

   

The breakdown of audit or non-audit fees is not disclosed or provided in a timely manner (in markets where such information is routinely available);

 

   

The auditors are being changed without explanation; or

 

   

Fees for non-audit/consulting services exceed a quarter of total fees paid to the auditor.*

Vote AGAINST auditor remuneration proposals if a company’s non-audit fees are excessive and auditor remuneration is presented as a separate voting item.

In circumstances where fees for non-audit services include fees related to significant one-time capital structure events: initial public offerings, bankruptcy emergencies, and spin-offs; and the company makes public disclosure of the amount and nature of those fees which are an exception to the standard “non-audit fee” category, then such fees may be excluded from the non-audit fees considered in determining the ratio of non-audit to audit fees.

*In the UK, the level of non-audit fees is calculated as non-audit fees over audit fees, which results in higher level of non-audit fees. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services uses a 50% non-audit fee benchmark in this market to determine if non-audit fees are excessive. If non-audit fees exceed 100% of audit fees, then Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote oppose both the auditor and election of audit committee members.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will apply its U.S. policy at U.S. firms incorporated in offshore tax and governance havens that do not qualify for disclosure exemptions, and vote against the reelection of auditors where auditor tenure exceeds seven years.

Discussion

Most major companies around the world use one of the major international auditing firms to conduct their audits. As such, concerns about the quality and objectivity of the audit are minimal, and the reappointment of the auditor is usually viewed as a routine matter. Audit fees tend to be highly competitive and vary little between companies. However, if a company proposes a new auditor or an auditor resigns and does not seek reelection, companies should offer an explanation to shareholders. If shareholders request an explanation for a change in auditor and the company or retiring auditor fails to provide one, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against the election of a new auditor. If an explanation is otherwise unavailable, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against this item.

 

B-201


Table of Contents

 

Many countries also require the appointment of censors, or special auditors who ensure that the board and management are in compliance with the company’s articles. The censors’ role is purely advisory in nature. Proposals to appoint censors are routine, as the censors usually act as a secondary auditor for special audit requirements.

The practice of auditors contributing non-audit services to companies is problematic, as illuminated by the accounting scandals around the world. When an auditor is paid more in consulting fees than for auditing, the company/auditor relationship is left open to conflicts of interest. Because accounting scandals evaporate shareholder value, any proposal to ratify auditors is examined for potential conflicts of interest, with particular attention to the fees paid to the auditor. When fees from non-audit services become significant without any clear safeguards against conflicts of interest, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the auditor’s reappointment.

APPOINTMENT OF INTERNAL STATUTORY AUDITORS

Vote FOR the appointment or reelection of statutory auditors, unless:

 

   

There are serious concerns about the statutory reports presented or the audit procedures used;

 

   

Questions exist concerning any of the statutory auditors being appointed; or

 

   

The auditors have previously served the company in an executive capacity or can otherwise be considered affiliated with the company.

Discussion

The appointment of internal statutory auditors is a routine request for companies in Latin America, Italy, Spain, Portugal, Japan, and Russia. The statutory auditing board is usually composed of three to five members, including a group chairman and two alternate members, all of whom are expected to be independent. In addition to the regular duty of verifying corporate accounts, the auditor board is responsible for supervising management and ensuring compliance with the law and articles of association. The auditors must perform an audit of the accounts every three months and present to shareholders a report on the balance sheet at the AGM. For most countries, the auditors are elected annually and may seek reelection. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the appointment of statutory auditors unless there are serious concerns about the reports presented or questions about an auditor’s qualifications.

ALLOCATION OF INCOME

Vote FOR approval of the allocation of income, unless:

 

   

The dividend payout ratio has been consistently below 30 percent without adequate explanation; or

 

   

The payout is excessive given the company’s financial position.

Discussion

Many countries require shareholders to approve the allocation of income generated during the year. These proposals usually, but not always, contain an allocation to dividends. When determining the acceptability of this proposal, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services focuses primarily on the payout ratio. Payouts of less than 30 percent or more than 100 percent are a trigger for further analysis. The minimum level of 30 percent is based on a review of international practice. Payouts of more than 100 percent are a signal that the company is dipping into reserves to make the payment.

Further analysis of payout ratios should include the following: an examination of historical payouts to determine if there is a long-term pattern of low payouts; exceptional events that may have artificially modified earnings for the year; the condition of a company’s balance sheet; comparisons with similar companies both domestically and internationally; and the classification of the company as growth or mature.

 

B-202


Table of Contents

 

Justifications for extreme payouts must be reviewed carefully. If the company has an adequate explanation for a certain payout, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the income allocation as proposed. However, if a company has a pattern of low payouts, fails to adequately justify the retention of capital, and is not experiencing above-average growth, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the proposal. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will also vote against the payout if a company appears to be maintaining an excessive payout that may affect its long-term health.

Although dividend payouts are still the predominant form of distribution of capital to shareholders, share buybacks have become more popular in some markets, such as Denmark. In these cases, companies have introduced policies to return capital to shareholders by way of share repurchases instead of through the payment of dividends. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services votes on proposals to omit the payment of a dividend in favor of a share buyback on a case-by-case basis by looking at factors such as whether repurchased shares will be cancelled or may be reissued, tax consequences for shareholders, liquidity of the shares, share price movements and the solvency ratio of the company.

STOCK (SCRIP) DIVIDEND ALTERNATIVE AND DIVIDEND REINVESTMENT PLANS

Vote FOR most stock (scrip) dividend proposals.

Vote AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

Discussion

Stock dividend alternatives, also referred to in some markets as “scrip” dividend alternatives or dividend reinvestment plans (DRIPS), offer shareholders the option of receiving their dividend payment in the form of fully paid ordinary shares and are common proposals worldwide. While dividend payments in the form of shares in lieu of cash do not immediately add to shareholder value, they allow companies to retain cash and to strengthen the position and commitment of long-term shareholders. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is generally supportive of such plans, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes stock dividend proposals that do not allow a cash option unless management shows that the cash outflow is detrimental to the company’s health and to long-term shareholder value.

AMENDMENTS TO ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

Votes on amendments to the articles of association are considered on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to amend a company’s articles of association are usually motivated by changes in the company’s legal and regulatory environment, although evolution of general business practice can also prompt amendments to articles. Such proposals are especially common whenever stock exchange listing rules are revised, new legislation is passed, or a court case exposes the need to close loopholes.

Amendments to articles range from minor spelling changes to the adoption of an entirely new set of articles. While the majority of such requests are of a technical and administrative nature, minor changes in wording can have a significant impact on corporate governance. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services carefully scrutinizes any changes to a company’s articles.

From a company’s perspective, it is often more efficient to adopt a new set of articles than to introduce numerous amendments. However, bundling changes that treat different provisions of the articles into one voting item prevents shareholders from separating items of concern from routine changes. By leaving a shareholder with an all-or-nothing choice, bundling allows companies to include negative provisions along with positive or neutral changes.

 

B-203


Table of Contents

 

When reviewing new or revised articles, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services classifies each change according to its potential impact on shareholder value and then weighs the package as a whole. The presence of one strongly negative change may warrant a recommendation against the resolution. In assigning these classifications, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services is not concerned with the nature of the article being amended, but rather focuses on whether the proposed change improves or worsens the existing provision.

The final criterion on which Taft-Hartley Advisory Services bases its decision is whether failure to pass a resolution would cause an immediate loss of shareholder value. In such cases, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports even a bundled resolution that includes negative changes.

CHANGE IN COMPANY FISCAL TERM

Vote FOR resolutions to change a company’s fiscal term unless a company’s motivation for the change is to postpone its annual general meeting (AGM).

Discussion

Companies routinely seek shareholder approval to change their fiscal year end. This is a decision best left to management. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes this resolution only if the company is changing its year-end to postpone its AGM. Most countries require companies to hold their AGM within a certain period of time after the close of the fiscal year. If a company is embroiled in a controversy, it might seek approval to amend its fiscal year end at an EGM to avoid controversial issues at an AGM. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes the change in year-end in these cases.

LOWER DISCLOSURE THRESHOLD FOR STOCK OWNERSHIP

Vote AGAINST resolutions to lower the stock ownership disclosure threshold below 5 percent unless specific reasons exist to implement a lower threshold.

Discussion

Required shareholder disclosure levels vary around the world. Some countries, such as Canada, require the disclosure of any stakes ten percent or higher, while other countries require lower disclosure levels. For example, the United Kingdom requires disclosure of stakes of three percent or greater. In some countries, shareholders may be asked from time to time to reduce the disclosure requirement at a specific company. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support such initiatives as they encourage greater disclosure by the company’s largest shareholders. However, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote AGAINST reductions that are unduly restrictive or could act as a pretext for an antitakeover device.

TRANSACT OTHER BUSINESS

Vote AGAINST other business when it appears as a voting item.

Discussion

This item provides a forum for questions and any other resolutions that may be brought up at the meeting. In most countries this item is a non-voting formality (not requiring a shareholder vote), but companies in certain countries do include other business as a voting item. Because shareholders who vote by proxy cannot know what issues will be raised under this item, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services cannot approve this request when asked for a vote. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recognizes that in most cases this item is a formality or includes discussion that will have no impact on shareholders, shareholders cannot risk the negative consequences of voting in advance on an item for which information has not been disclosed.

 

B-204


Table of Contents

DIRECTOR AND SUPERVISORY BOARD MEMBER ELECTIONS

Vote FOR management nominees in the election of directors, unless:

 

   

Adequate disclosure has not been provided in a timely manner;

 

   

There are clear concerns about the past performance of the company or the board, including;

 

   

Questionable finances or restatements

 

   

Questionable transactions with conflicts of interest

 

   

The board fails to meet minimum corporate governance standards;

 

   

There is a lack of independence on the board and/or its key committees;

 

   

There are any records of abuses against minority shareholder interests;

 

   

The board takes actions that are not in shareholders’ best interests (excessive executive compensation, adopting antitakeover devices, failure to respond to shareholder concerns/wishes, or demonstrating a “lack of duty or care”); or

 

   

The board has been insensitive to labor interests, human rights, supplier codes of conduct, or has engaged in other corporate activities that affect the reputation of the company in the global market.

Generally vote FOR employee and/or labor representatives.

Votes AGAINST/WITHHOLD votes on individual nominees, key committee members or the entire board can be triggered by one or more of the following concerns:

 

   

Lack of a majority independent board;

 

   

Attendance of director nominees at board meetings of less than 75 percent without valid reason or explanation;

 

   

Lack of full independence on key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, and nominating committees);

 

   

Failure to establish any key board committees (i.e. audit, compensation, or nominating) including where the board serves in the capacity of a key committee, and where there is insufficient information to determine whether key committees exist, who the committee members are, or whether the committee members are independent;

 

   

Presence of a non-independent board chairman;

 

   

Directors serving on an excessive number of other boards which could compromise their primary duties. In markets where the number of board appointments is routinely available, an excessive number of boards is defined as;

 

   

For non-executive directors, more than five total non-executive directorships.

 

   

For executive directors, i) more than three total non-executive directorships; or ii) other executive or board chair positions.

 

   

For board chairs, i) more than four total non-executive directorships; or ii) more than two board chair positions; or iii) other executive positions.

 

   

The names of nominees are unavailable or not provided in a timely manner (in markets where this information is routinely available);

 

   

Director terms are not disclosed exceed market norms;

 

B-205


Table of Contents

 

   

Egregious actions including;

 

   

Material failures of governance, stewardship, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company

 

   

Failure to replace management as appropriate

 

   

Egregious actions related to the director(s)’ service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.

For bundled director elections, vote AGAINST the entire slate if any of the concerns above apply to a particular nominee.

Discussion

Most countries around the world maintain an Anglo-Saxon board structure, as seen in the United States, in which executive and nonexecutive directors are organized into a single board. However, companies in a number of countries maintain two-tiered board structures, comprising a supervisory board of nonexecutive directors and a management board with executive directors. The supervisory board oversees the actions of the management board, while the management board is responsible for the company’s daily operations. Companies with two-tiered boards elect members to the supervisory board only; management board members are appointed by the supervisory board.

Depending on the country, shareholders will be asked to either elect directors or supervisory board members at annual meetings. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services considers director/supervisory board elections to be one of the most important voting decisions that shareholders make, especially because shareholders are only given the opportunity to review their companies’ operations once a year at the AGM. Thus, if detailed information on boards or nominees is available, analysis to the highest degree possible is warranted. Directors and supervisory board members function as the representatives of shareholders and stakeholders throughout the year and are therefore, a crucial avenue of ongoing influence on management.

Levels of disclosure regarding directors vary widely. In some countries, such as the United Kingdom, Canada, and Australia, companies publish detailed information such as director biographies, share ownership, and related information that aids shareholders in determining the level of director independence. In these cases, we apply standards of board and key board committee independence. In many other countries, the only information available on directors is their names, while still other countries disclose no information at all. In low-disclosure markets where sufficiently detailed information about directors is unavailable, it could be counterproductive to vote against directors on the basis of a lack of information. Opposition to specific nominees or boards should be supported by specific problems or concerns.

While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the annual election of directors, boards in many countries are divided into two or more classes that are elected on a staggered basis. This system of classified boards is common across the world. Only Canadian companies routinely elect the entire board on an annual basis, but even in Canada companies may classify their board if an appropriate amendment is made to the articles. In certain countries, executive directors may be appointed for terms of up to six years, and a company’s articles may give executive directors protected board seats under which they are not subject to shareholder election. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes directors should stand for reelection annually and be accountable to shareholders on an annual basis, and opposes article amendment proposals seeking extensions of director terms. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also opposes protected board seats and preferential treatment of executive directors. In some countries the trend is moving toward limiting terms for directors. In The Netherlands, the corporate governance code recommends that management and supervisory board members be subject to maximum four-year terms. Although we recognize that four-year terms maybe the standard in the some markets, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the election of new directors or the reelection of an existing director when their terms are not disclosed or where their term lengths exceed market norms.

 

B-206


Table of Contents

 

When reviewing director election proposals (where possible given information disclosure), Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines board composition, company performance, and any negative views or information on either the company or individual directors. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services determines the number of executive and independent directors on the board, the existence and composition of board committees, and the independence of the chairman. An independent director is one whose only significant relationship with the company is through its board seat. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services defines members of supervisory boards, which represent organized workers’ interests, as independent. In cases where board composition is of concern, the company’s general health and its recent financial performance may play a part in the evaluation of directors. Individual director information is also considered, including share ownership among director nominees. In markets where board independence composition information is routinely available, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally oppose all non-independent director nominees if the board is not at least 50 percent (majority) independent. For U.S. firms incorporated in offshore tax or governance havens that do not qualify for disclosure exemptions, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will apply its U.S. policy and vote against non-independent director nominees if the board is not two-thirds majority independent or where key board committees are not completely independent.

While complete independence on board committees is widely recognized as best practice, there are some markets in which it is still common to find executive directors serving as committee members. Whenever the level of disclosure is adequate to determine whether a committee includes company insiders, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally vote against these executive directors.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also takes into account the attendance records of directors when such information is provided to shareholders, using a benchmark attendance rate of 75 percent of board meetings. If an individual director fails to attend at least 75 percent of board meetings, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services makes further inquiries to the company regarding the absences. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against/withhold votes from the director unless the company has provided a reasonable explanation for the absences. International companies tend to have directors who reside in other countries on their boards, making attendance difficult. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services understands the difficulties imposed on such directors, failing to attend meetings prevents directors from fulfilling their fiduciary obligations and adequately representing shareholder interests. Other business obligations and conflicting travel schedules are not acceptable reasons for consistently poor attendance records. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the use of teleconferencing and videoconferencing to cope with the increasing time and travel demands faced by directors in global business.

For shareholder nominees, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services places the persuasive burden on the nominee or the proposing shareholder to prove that they are better suited to serve on the board than management’s nominees. Serious consideration of shareholder nominees will be given in cases where there are clear and compelling reasons for the nominee to join the board. These nominees must also demonstrate a clear ability to contribute positively to board deliberations; some nominees may have hidden or narrow agendas and may unnecessarily contribute to divisiveness among directors.

In many countries it is customary to elect a single slate of directors. We do not approve of this practice because shareholders may wish to express differing views as to the suitability of the director nominees and should have the ability to cast ballots with respect to individuals rather than the entire slate. Given improving best practice in more sophisticated markets, which are moving away from single slate director election items, we will generally oppose director nominees if their election is not presented to shareholders as an individual item in these markets, and will oppose slate nominees in markets where the practice is prevalent and there are concerns with a particular director nominee up for election.

In recent years, the concept that directors should not serve on an excessive number of boards has gained more support as a legitimate governance concern. A common view among many investors is that a director will not be an effective monitor on any board if he/she serves on numerous boards. In markets where disclosure is sufficient (such as detailed director biographies which include information on the director’s role on the board and

 

B-207


Table of Contents

other external appointments both in the local market and abroad), and markets permit individual election of directors, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against a candidate when he/she holds an excessive number of board appointments. Executive directors are expected not to hold other executive or chairmanship positions. They may, however, hold up to two other non-executive directorships. Chairmen are expected not to hold other executive positions or more than one other chairmanship position. They may, however, hold up to three other non-executive directorships. NEDs who do not hold executive or chairmanship positions may hold up to four other non-executive directorships. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will take into account board positions held in global publicly-listed companies. An adverse vote will not be applied to a director within a company where he/she serves as CEO or chair; instead, any negative votes will be applied to his/her additional seats on other company boards.

Director accountability and competence have become issues of prime importance given the failings in oversight exposed by the global financial crisis. There is also concern over the environment in the boardrooms of certain markets, where past failures appear to be no impediment to continued or new appointments at major companies and may not be part of the evaluation process at companies in considering whether an individual is, or continues to be, fit for the role and best able to serve shareholders’ interests. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider a potential negative vote at the board, committee, or individual level, if a director has had significant involvement with a failed company, or has in the past appeared not to have acted in the best interests of all shareholders, and/or where substantial doubts have been raised about a director’s ability to serve as an effective monitor of management and in shareholders’ best interests including consideration of past performance on other boards.

CONTESTED DIRECTOR ELECTIONS

For contested elections of directors (e.g. the election of shareholder nominees or the dismissal of incumbent directors) Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the factors below in determining which directors are best suited to add value for shareholders:

 

   

Company performance relative to its peers;

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents;

 

   

Independence of directors/nominees;

 

   

Experience and skills of board candidates and their ability to contribute positively to board deliberations and overall board performance;

 

   

Governance profile of the company;

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment;

 

   

Responsiveness to shareholders;

 

   

Whether a takeover offer has been rebuffed;

 

   

Whether minority or majority representation is being sought.

When analyzing a contested election of directors, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally focuses on two central questions: (1) Have the dissidents proved that board change is warranted? And (2) if so, are the dissident board nominees likely to effect positive change? (i.e., maximize long-term shareholder value)

Discussion

Once fairly infrequent, contested elections, (also referred to as proxy contests) have become increasingly common in recent years as large shareholders, frustrated by poor returns and unresponsive boards, have sought to challenge the status quo. Even when dissidents do not achieve board seats, studies indicate that at least some of their objectives are often achieved because the response to a proxy contest, or one that was narrowly averted,

 

B-208


Table of Contents

usually includes new strategic initiatives, a restructuring program, governance changes, or selected management changes. Based on these considerations, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ framework for the evaluation of contested elections has the ultimate the goal of increasing long-term value for shareholders.

DIRECTOR FEES

Vote FOR proposals to award director fees unless the amounts are excessive relative to other companies in the country or industry.

Vote AGAINST proposals to introduce retirement benefits for nonexecutive directors.

Vote non-executive director compensation proposals that include both cash and share-based components on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote proposals that bundle compensation for both non-executive and executive directors into a single resolution on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Director fees in most countries are not controversial. Fees for nonexecutive directors have been rising in recent years, as such directors around the world are being asked to take on more responsibility for company affairs. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports increases in director fees unless they are excessive relative to fees paid by other companies in the same country or industry. The primary focus of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ evaluation is on fees paid to nonexecutive directors or fees paid to all directors, separate from the salaries of executive directors. In many countries, only an aggregate amount payable to nonexecutives or to all directors is disclosed.

Retirement benefits for nonexecutive directors are inappropriate, as they increase the directors’ financial reliance on the company and could call into question the objectivity of their decision-making. In addition, most directors have served as senior executives of other companies, and adequate retirement benefits should be provided through these companies. The only caveat to this policy would be for professional nonexecutive directors such as those found in the United Kingdom. However, requests for such benefits in the United Kingdom are rare, and the appropriateness of using shareholder funds in this manner is questionable.

DISCHARGE OF BOARD AND MANAGEMENT

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on the discharge of the board and management:

Vote AGAINST the discharge of directors, including members of the management board and/or supervisory board, if there is reliable information about significant and compelling controversies that the board is not fulfilling its fiduciary duties warranted by:

 

   

A lack of oversight or actions by board members which invoke shareholder distrust related to malfeasance or poor supervision, such as operating in private or company interest rather than in shareholder interest; or

 

   

Any legal issues (e.g. civil/criminal) aiming to hold the board responsible for breach of trust in the past or related to currently alleged actions yet to be confirmed (and not only the fiscal year in question), such as price fixing, insider trading, bribery, fraud, and other illegal actions; or

 

   

Other egregious governance issues where shareholders will bring legal action against the company or its directors.

 

B-209


Table of Contents

For markets which do not routinely request discharge resolutions (e.g. common law countries or markets where discharge is not mandatory), Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may express its concern with the board in other appropriate agenda items, such as approval of the annual accounts or other relevant resolutions to express discontent with the board.

Discussion

The annual formal discharge of board and management represents shareholder approval of actions taken during the year. Discharge is a tacit vote of confidence in the company’s management and policies. It does not necessarily eliminate the possibility of future shareholder action, although it does make such action more difficult to pursue. Meeting agendas normally list proposals to discharge both the board and management as one agenda item.

This is a routine item in many countries, and discharge is generally granted unless a shareholder states a specific reason for withholding discharge and plans to undertake legal action. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will withhold discharge when there are serious questions about actions of the board or management for the year in question or legal action is being taken against the board by other shareholders. Withholding discharge is a serious matter and is advisable only when a shareholder has concrete evidence of negligence or abuse on the part of the board or management, has plans to take legal action, or has knowledge of other shareholders’ plans to take legal action.

If evidence suggests that one or more board or management members are responsible for problems such as fraud or grave mismanagement, shareholders can withhold discharge from these individuals and pursue further legal action. Poor performance that can be directly linked to flagrant error or neglect on the part of the board or management, or board actions that are detrimental to shareholders’ interests, may also constitute grounds for voting against discharge.

If shareholders approve discharge of the board and management, they may face a greater challenge if they subsequently decide to pursue legal action against these parties. Shareholders would be required to prove that management or the board did not supply correct and complete information regarding the matter in question.

DIRECTOR AND OFFICER LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION, AND AUDITOR INDEMNIFICATION

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, proposals seeking indemnification and liability protection for directors and officers.

Vote AGAINST proposals to indemnify auditors.

Discussion

Management proposals typically seek shareholder approval to adopt an amendment to the company’s charter to eliminate or limit the personal liability of directors to the company and its shareholders for monetary damages for any breach of fiduciary duty to the fullest extent permitted by law. In contrast, shareholder proposals seek to provide for personal monetary liability for fiduciary breaches arising from gross negligence. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recognizes that a company may have a more difficult time attracting and retaining directors if they are subject to personal monetary liability, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes the great responsibility and authority of directors justifies holding them accountable for their actions. Each proposal addressing director liability will be evaluated consistent with this philosophy. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may support these proposals when the company persuasively argues that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may often oppose management proposals and support shareholder proposals in light of our philosophy of promoting director accountability.

 

B-210


Table of Contents

 

Specifically, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose management proposals that limit a director’s liability for (i) a breach of the duty of loyalty, (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or involving intentional misconduct or knowing violations of the law, (iii) acts involving the unlawful purchases or redemptions of stock, (iv) the payment of unlawful dividends, or (v) the receipt of improper personal benefits. In addition, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally oppose proposals to reduce or eliminate directors’ personal liability when litigation is pending against current board members.

By indemnifying its directors and officers, a company promises to reimburse them for certain legal expenses, damages, and judgments incurred as a result of lawsuits relating to their corporate actions, thereby effectively becoming the insurer for its officers and directors (the company usually purchases insurance to cover its own risk). Proposals to indemnify a company’s directors differ from those to eliminate or reduce their liability because with indemnification directors may still be liable for an act or omission, but the company will bear the expense.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote in favor of indemnification proposals that contain provisions limiting such insurance to acts carried out on behalf of the company. The directors covered under the indemnification must be acting in good faith on company business and must be found innocent of any civil or criminal charges for duties performed on behalf of the company. Additionally, the company may persuasively argue that such action is necessary to attract and retain directors, but we will oppose indemnification when it is being proposed to insulate directors from actions they have already taken.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes providing indemnity insurance to auditors. These payments call into question the objectivity of the auditor in carrying out the audit, as the fees paid on its behalf could be greater than the audit fees alone. Eliminating concerns about being sued for carelessness could also lead to a decrease in the quality of the audit. Given the substantial settlements against auditors in recent years for poor audit practices, the cost of such insurance to the company and its shareholders is unwarranted.

BOARD STRUCTURE

Vote FOR proposals to fix board size.

Vote AGAINST the introduction of classified boards and mandatory retirement ages for directors.

Vote AGAINST proposals to alter board structure or size in the context of a fight for control of the company or the board.

Discussion

Resolutions relating to board structures range from fixing the number of directors or establishing a minimum or maximum number of directors to introducing classified boards and director term limits.

Board Size

Proposals to fix board size are common and are routinely approved. Proposals to establish a range of board size are also frequent; a range of two or three open slots relative to the existing board size is reasonable, as it gives the company some flexibility to attract potentially valuable board members during the year. Latitude beyond this range is inappropriate, however, because companies can use this freedom to hinder unwanted influence from potential acquirers or large shareholders.

Adopt Classified Board

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that all directors stand for reelection every year. All directors should be accountable to shareholders on an annual basis, as the ability to elect directors is the single most important use of the shareholder franchise.

 

B-211


Table of Contents

 

While classified boards are the norm in most countries, some companies have chosen to place their directors up for annual election. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports initiatives to declassify boards and opposes proposals to classify previously unstaggered boards. Classifying the board makes it more difficult to effect a change of control through a proxy contest; because only a minority of the directors are elected each year, a dissident shareholder would be unable to win control of the board in a single election.

Introduction of Mandatory Age of Retirement

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that age should not be the sole factor in determining a director’s value to a company. Rather, each director’s performance should be evaluated on the basis of their individual contribution and experience.

Altering Board Size

Companies may attempt to increase board size in order to add related or like-minded directors to the board. Conversely, establishing a minimum number of directors could make it easier to remove independent directors from the board. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services considers these proposals on a case-by-case basis.

All proposals to alter board size during a proxy fight or other possible contests for control should be opposed. Allowing directors to alter the terms of a contest while it is underway is not in shareholders’ interests, as this tactic could be used to thwart a takeover that is in shareholders’ interests.

CAPITAL SYSTEMS

Companies have one of two main types of capital systems: authorized and conditional. Both systems provide companies with the means to finance business activities, but they are considerably different in structure. Which system is used by a company is determined by the economic and legal structure of the market in which it operates.

Authorized Capital System

The authorized capital system sets a limit in a company’s articles on the total number of shares that can be issued by the company’s board. The system allows companies to issue shares from this preapproved limit, although in many markets shareholder approval must be obtained prior to an issuance. Companies also request shareholder approval for increases in authorization when the amount of shares contained in the articles is inadequate for issuance authorities. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews proposals for such increases based on the following criteria: the history of issuance requests; the size of the request; the purpose of the issuance (general or specific) associated with the increase in authorization; and the status of preemptive rights (see pol.19 and pol.21).

Conditional Capital System

Under the conditional capital system, companies seek authorizations for pools of capital with fixed periods of availability. For example, if a company seeks to establish a pool of capital for general issuance purposes, it requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable piecemeal at the discretion of the board for a fixed period of time. Shares unissued after the fixed time period lapse. This type of authority would be used to carry out a general rights issue or small issuances without preemptive rights.

Requests for a specific issuance authority are tied to a specific transaction or purpose, such as an acquisition or the servicing of convertible securities. Such authorities cannot be used for any purpose other than that specified in the authorization. In this case, a company requests the creation of a certain number of shares with or without preemptive rights, issuable as needed for the specific purpose requested. This pool of conditional capital also carries a fixed expiration date.

 

B-212


Table of Contents

 

In reviewing these proposals, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services takes into consideration the existence of pools of capital from previous years. Because most capital authorizations are for several years, new requests may be made on top of the existing pool of capital. While most requests contain a provision to eliminate earlier pools and replace them with the current request, this is not always the case. Thus, if existing pools of capital are being left in place, the aggregate potential dilution amount from all capital should be considered.

SHARE ISSUANCE REQUESTS

Vote FOR general issuance requests with preemptive rights up to 50 percent of issued capital;

Vote FOR general issuance requests without preemptive rights up to 10 percent of issue capital; and

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis specific issuance requests with or without preemptive rights up to any amount depending on the purpose for the issuance.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis those issuance requests that exceed one-year periods.

General Issuances

General issuance requests under both authorized and conditional capital systems allow companies to issue shares to raise funds for general financing purposes. Approval of such requests gives companies sufficient flexibility to carry out ordinary business activities without having to bear the expense of calling shareholder meetings for every issuance.

Issuances can be carried out with or without preemptive rights. Preemptive rights permit shareholders to share proportionately in any new issuances of stock. These rights guarantee existing shareholders the first opportunity to purchase shares of new issuances of stock in the class they own in an amount equal to the percentage of the class they already own. Corporate law in many countries recognizes preemptive rights and requires shareholder approval for the disapplication of such rights.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that the ability to increase share capital by 50 percent through a rights issue (with preemptive rights) provides the company with sufficient financing to meet most contingencies. Rights issues for general capital needs of less than 50 percent of outstanding capital warrant shareholder approval. Issuance authorities of more than 50 percent can lead to excessive cash calls on shareholders, requiring them to provide the funds necessary to maintain their relative positions in the company or to accept substantial dilution.

In some cases, companies may need the ability to raise funds for routine business contingencies without the expense of carrying out a rights issue. Such contingencies could include the servicing of option plans, small acquisitions, or payment for services. When companies make issuance requests without preemptive rights, shareholders suffer dilution as a result of such issuances. Therefore, authorizations should be limited to a fixed number of shares or a percentage of capital at the time of issuance. While conventions regarding this type of authority vary widely among countries, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services routinely approves issuance requests without preemptive rights for up to ten percent of a company’s outstanding capital.

In certain markets, issuance requests are made for several years. This is often the case in France, Germany and Spain. In these situations, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will consider the per annum dilution equivalent as well as consider whether or not the authority can be renewed before the lapse of the specified period. Whenever possible, we will monitor actual share issuances to assure that the company is not abusing the privilege.

Specific Issuances

Specific issuance requests should be judged on their individual merits. For example, a company may request the issuance of shares for an acquisition in the form of a rights issue to raise funds for a cash payment, or else a

 

B-213


Table of Contents

company could request an issuance without preemptive rights for use in a share-based acquisition or issuance to a third party. Such a request could be of any size, and Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support the request as long as the proposal is sound. A more routine request would be an authority to issue shares without preemptive rights for issuance as needed upon conversion of convertible securities or to service a share option plan. These shares can only be used for the purpose defined in the resolution.

INCREASES IN AUTHORIZED CAPITAL

Vote FOR nonspecific proposals to increase authorized capital up to 50 percent over the current authorization.

Vote FOR specific proposals to increase authorized capital to any amount unless the specific purpose of the increase (such as a share-based acquisition or merger) does not meet Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines for the purpose being proposed.

Vote AGAINST proposals to adopt unlimited capital authorizations.

Discussion

Increases in authorized capital are requested both for general financing flexibility and to provide for a specific purpose. Companies need an adequate buffer of unissued capital in order to take advantage of opportunities during the year, and thus they often request increases in authorized capital for no specific purpose other than to retain this flexibility. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that approving such requests is reasonable.

An increase of 50 percent over the existing authorization gives the company sufficient flexibility in any given year but also limits the company’s ability to abuse this privilege. If a company wishes to issue shares for any unforeseen reason during the year that would double (or possibly triple) outstanding share capital, an EGM to seek shareholder approval is justified.

Another important consideration is the status of preemptive rights. Not all countries recognize shareholders’ preemptive rights, and excessive authorizations could lead to substantial dilution for existing shareholders. When preemptive rights are not guaranteed, companies do not need shareholder approval for share issuances as long as the issuance does not result in an increase above the authorized capital limit.

For specific requests, increases in capital up to any size may be justified if the purpose of the new authorization is in shareholders’ interests. Such increases may be needed to fund a variety of corporate activities, and thus each proposal must be reviewed on its individual merits.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against proposals seeking to increase authorized capital to an unlimited number of shares. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not believe that companies need unlimited financial flexibility to transact ordinary business because such an arrangement precludes management from periodically consulting shareholders for new capital. Unlimited authorizations may also be used as antitakeover devices, and they have the potential for substantial voting and earnings dilution. As such, they are not in shareholders’ best interests.

REDUCTION OF CAPITAL

Vote FOR proposals to reduce capital unless the terms are unfavorable to shareholders.

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reduce capital in connection with corporate restructurings.

 

B-214


Table of Contents

 

Discussion

Proposals to reduce capital are usually the result of a significant corporate restructuring in the face of bankruptcy. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally supports such proposals because opposition could lead to insolvency, which is not in shareholders’ interests. Evaluation of this type of proposal should take a realistic approach to the company’s situation.

CAPITAL STRUCTURES

Vote FOR resolutions that seek to maintain or convert to a one share, one vote capital structure.

Vote AGAINST requests for the creation or continuation of dual class capital structures or the creation of new or additional super-voting shares.

Discussion

A key decision for any business is determining its capital structure. When timed correctly, sophisticated capital management — finding the right mix of equity, long-term debt, and short-term financing — can enhance shareholder returns. This process involves coordination of important issues, including dividend policy, tax and interest rates, types of assets, opportunities for growth, ability to finance new projects internally, and cost of obtaining additional capital.

These decisions are best left to a company’s board and senior management, who should be given the latitude to determine the company’s capital structure. However, shareholders should be aware that many financing decisions could have an adverse effect on shareholder returns. For example, additional equity financing may reduce an existing shareholder’s ownership interest and can dilute the value of the investment. Some capital requests can be used as takeover defenses; in response to this situation, company laws establish limits on management’s authority to issue new capital and often require shareholder approval for significant changes in management’s existing authorizations.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports a one share, one vote policy and opposes mechanisms that skew voting rights. Shareholders’ voting rights should accrue in accordance with their equity capital commitment to the company. Dual class capital structures entrench certain shareholders and management, insulating them from possible takeovers or other external influence or action. The interests of parties with voting control may not be the same as those of shareholders constituting a majority of the company’s capital. Additionally, research and market experience have shown that companies with dual class capital structures or other antitakeover mechanisms consistently trade at a discount to similar companies without such structures.

When companies with dual class capital structures seek shareholder approval for the creation of new shares, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes the creation of additional super-voting shares because this perpetuates the dual class structure. If companies are seeking to increase ordinary or subordinate share capital, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews such requests on a case-by-case basis. If the shares are needed for a specific purpose, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will approve as long as the proposal meets the issuance guidelines for specific requests. Refusing such requests could cause an immediate loss of shareholder value by not allowing the company to carry out its ordinary business. However, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes general share creation requests on the grounds that they would perpetuate unequal voting structures. If shareholders routinely approve the creation of ordinary or subordinate voting shares, the company has no incentive to reform its capital structure. By not approving such requests, shareholders can send a signal of dissatisfaction to management.

PREFERRED STOCK

Vote FOR the creation of a new class of preferred stock or for issuances of preferred stock up to 50 percent of issued capital unless the terms of the preferred stock would adversely affect the rights of existing shareholders.

 

B-215


Table of Contents

 

Vote FOR the creation/issuance of convertible preferred stock as long as the maximum number of common shares that could be issued upon conversion meets Taft-Hartley Advisory Services guidelines on equity issuance requests.

Vote AGAINST the creation of blank check preferred stock unless the board expressly states that the authorization will not be used as a takeover defense.

Vote proposals to increase blank check preferred authorizations on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST the creation of a new class of preference shares that would carry superior voting rights to the common shares.

Discussion

Preferred stock (also known as preference shares) is an equity security, but it has certain features that liken it to debt instruments, such as fixed dividend payments, seniority of claims relative to regular common stock, and (in most cases) no voting rights except on matters that affect the seniority of preferred stock as a class. Preferred stock usually ranks senior to a company’s ordinary shares with respect to dividends and the distribution of assets or winding down of the company. Companies often request approval for the creation of a new class of preferred stock, the issuance of preferred stock, and the introduction of blank check preferred stock authorization. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that the terms of preferred stock be set out at the time of the issuance or authorization request.

Preferred stock can be an effective means of raising capital without increasing debt levels, especially if a company has recently concluded a series of acquisitions. In determining the acceptability of proposals relating to preferred stock, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines the rights and terms of the proposed shares, including their designation, conditions, restrictions, and limitations. Whether or not the preferred shares carry voting rights is also considered, along with their conversion ratio (if the shares are convertible into common shares). Also important is the company’s justification for issuing or authorizing preferred stock. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that would not result in excessive dilution or adversely affect the rights of holders of common shares.

BLANK CHECK PREFERRED STOCK

Companies may also seek shareholder approval for blank check preferred stock, which are blanket authorities to issue preferred stock under which the directors are allowed to set the size, terms, and recipient of such shares at the time of issuance. Blank check preferred stock can be used for legitimate corporate purposes such as raising capital or making acquisitions. By not establishing the terms of preferred stock at the time the class of stock is created, companies maintain the flexibility to tailor their preferred stock offerings to prevailing market conditions. However, blank check preferred stock can also be used as an entrenchment device. The ability to issue a block of preferred stock with multiple voting or conversion rights to a friendly investor is a powerful takeover defense. As such, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services does not support the creation of blank check preferred stock unless the board clearly states that the authorization will not be used to thwart a takeover bid.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also considers, on a case-by-case basis, proposals to increase authorizations of blank check preferred stock when shareholders have already approved the class of stock and the company has a history of issuing such stock for legitimate financing purposes. Theoretically, companies with authorized blank check preferred stock can use these shares for antitakeover purposes as long as there are a few shares remaining, as they are free to set voting or conversion terms with each issue. Therefore, an increase in authorization may have little effect on the usage of this stock. In cases where a company has issued preferred stock from its authorization for legitimate financing purposes, there is no reason to object to an increase.

 

B-216


Table of Contents

DEBT ISSUANCE REQUESTS

Vote non-convertible debt issuance requests with or without preemptive rights on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST the creation or issuance of convertible debt with preemptive rights if the conversion increases the company’s share capital by more than 50 percent over the current outstanding capital.

Vote AGAINST the creation or issuance of convertible debt without preemptive rights if the conversion increases the company’s share capital by more than 10 percent over the current outstanding capital.

Vote FOR proposals to restructure existing debt arrangements unless the terms of the restructuring would adversely affect the rights of shareholders.

Discussion

Debt issuance is a popular financing strategy. Debt instruments are often issued with the right to convert into equity securities. Many companies issue debt denominated in currencies other than their own. Bonds may be issued with or without preemptive rights.

Companies routinely issue bonds directly to shareholders in order to raise funds while enjoying low borrowing costs. Convertible bonds give holders the choice of becoming shareholders, thereby increasing the shareholder base and liquidity of the company’s stock, or selling their newly converted shares on the open market. The issuance of unsecured debt often includes warrants, which are detached at the time of bond issuance. Warrants are usually attached to a debt issuance in order to enhance the marketability of the accompanying fixed income security.

When evaluating a debt issuance request, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines the issuing company’s present financial situation. The main factor for analysis is the company’s current debt-to-equity ratio, or gearing level. A high gearing level may incline markets and financial analysts to downgrade the company’s bond rating, increasing its investment risk factor in the process. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services routinely approves of debt issuances for companies when the gearing level is between zero and 50 percent. If the company’s gearing level is higher than 50 percent, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services then factors in other financial statistics, such as the company’s growth over the past five years relative to earnings or market capitalization, recent corporate events that might affect the company’s bottom line (such as the acquisition of a major competitor or the release of a revolutionary product), and the normal debt levels in the company’s industry and country of origin. In the case of convertible bonds, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also takes into consideration the total level of dilution that would result at the time of conversion. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines for capital increases would then be applied.

PLEDGING OF ASSETS FOR DEBT

Vote proposals to approve the pledging of assets for debt on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

In certain countries, shareholder approval is required when a company needs to secure a debt issuance with its assets. In many cases, this is a routine request and is a formality under the relevant law. When reviewing such proposals, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services takes into account the terms of the proposed debt issuance and the company’s overall debt level. If both of these factors are acceptable, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support these requests.

INCREASE IN BORROWING POWERS

Vote proposals to approve increases in a company’s borrowing powers on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

B-217


Table of Contents

 

Vote AGAINST the removal of a limit on borrowing powers.

Discussion

In some countries, companies are required to seek shareholder approval for increases in their aggregate borrowing power authorities. The aggregate limit on the board’s ability to borrow money is often fixed in a company’s articles, and shareholder approval to change this limit is therefore legally required. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that a company’s financing needs are best determined by the board, and modest increases in borrowing powers are necessary to allow the company to take advantage of new acquisition opportunities or to complete development and restructuring projects. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ analysis of borrowing power increase requests take into account management’s stated need for the increase, the size of the increase, and the company’s current gearing level. Large increases in borrowing powers can sometimes result in dangerously high debt-to-equity ratios that could harm shareholder value. If an increase is excessive without sufficient justification and if a company already has exceptionally high gearing compared to its industry, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the request.

SHARE REPURCHASE PLANS

Vote FOR share repurchase programs/market repurchase authorities, unless:

 

   

Maximum volume: 10 percent for market repurchase within any single authority and 10 percent of outstanding shares to be kept in treasury (“on the shelf”);

 

   

Duration does not exceed 18 months;

In addition, vote AGAINST any proposal where:

 

   

The repurchase can be used for takeover defenses;

 

   

There is clear evidence of abuse;

 

   

There is no safeguard against selective buybacks;

 

   

Pricing provisions and safeguards are deemed to be unreasonable in light of market practice.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may support share repurchase plans in excess of 10 percent volume under exceptional circumstances, such as one-off company specific events (e.g. capital re-structuring). Such proposals will be assessed case-by-case based on merits, which should be clearly disclosed in the annual report, provided that following conditions are met:

 

   

The overall balance of the proposed plan seems to be clearly in shareholder’s interests;

 

   

The plan still respects the 10 percent maximum of shares to be kept in treasury.

For Italy and Germany, vote FOR share-repurchase plans and share reissuance plans that would use call and put options if the following criteria are met:

 

   

The duration of the authorization is limited in time to no more than 18 months;

 

   

The total number of shares covered by the authorization is disclosed;

 

   

The number of shares that would be purchased with call options and/or sold with put options is limited to a maximum of five percent of currently outstanding capital (or half of the total amounts allowed by law in Italy and Germany);

 

   

A financial institution, with experience conducting sophisticated transactions, is indicated as the party responsible for the trading; and

 

   

The company has a clean track record regarding repurchases.

 

B-218


Table of Contents

 

Discussion

Proposals regarding share repurchase plans are routine in most countries, and such plans are usually sufficiently regulated by local laws or listing requirements to protect shareholder interests.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks for the following conditions in share repurchase plans: limitations on a company’s ability to use the plan to repurchase shares from third parties at a premium; limitations on the exercise of the authority to thwart takeover threats; and a requirement that repurchases be made at arm’s length through independent third parties and that selective repurchases require shareholder approval.

Some shareholders object to companies repurchasing shares, preferring to see extra cash invested in new businesses or paid out as dividends. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that when timed correctly, stock repurchases are a legitimate use of corporate funds and can add to long-term shareholder returns.

However, in certain instances, share buybacks are used to fund stock option plans. In these cases, cash is being used to fund stock options plans, which in most cases are a form of management compensation. When possible, we will make efforts to learn whether share repurchase plans are being used to fund stock option plans. In these instances, extra scrutiny will be paid, and a repurchase plan may be opposed.

For markets that either generally do not specify the maximum duration of the authority or seek a duration beyond 18 months that is allowable under market specific legislation, we will assess the company’s historic practice. If there is evidence that a company has sought shareholder approval for the authority to repurchase shares on an annual basis, we will support the proposed authority.

REISSUANCE OF SHARES REPURCHASED

Vote FOR requests to reissue any repurchased shares unless there is clear evidence of abuse of this authority in the past.

Discussion

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally believes that properly timed repurchases of company shares can enhance shareholder value and improve general shareholder returns. With good timing and proper safeguards, the same returns and improvements in shareholder value can be generated through the reissuance of the shares repurchased. In most countries, the text of this general mandate provides sufficient shareholder protection to make this item routine. When reviewing such proposals, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services takes into account the country’s legal framework for such reissuances and the company’s history of reissuing shares under the authority.

CAPITALIZATION OF RESERVES FOR BONUS ISSUES/INCREASE IN PAR VALUE

Vote FOR requests to capitalize reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase par value.

Discussion

Companies routinely carry out bonus issues of shares or increases in par value to existing shareholders, usually through the capitalization of reserves from either the share premium reserve or the retained earnings account. Capitalization of these reserves — transferring them into the share capital account — usually requires shareholder approval. These issuances essentially function as dividends.

When companies increase par value or capitalize reserves and distribute new fully paid shares to shareholders free of charge through a bonus issue, there is no cost to shareholders to maintain their stakes and no risk of dilution. This procedure transfers wealth to shareholders and does not significantly impact share value. The only impact on shareholders is that by increasing the number of shares on issue, the company could increase liquidity, enhance marketability, and ultimately expand its shareholder base.

 

B-219


Table of Contents

 

REORGANIZATIONS/RESTRUCTURINGS

Vote reorganizations and restructurings on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Requests to approve corporate reorganizations or restructurings range from the routine shuffling of subsidiaries within a group to major rescue programs for ailing companies. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services usually approves such resolutions unless there are clear conflicts of interest among the various parties, shareholders’ rights are being negatively affected, or certain groups or shareholders appear to be getting a better deal at the expense of general shareholders.

In the case of routine reorganizations of assets or subsidiaries within a group, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ primary focus with the proposed changes is to ensure that shareholder value is being preserved. This includes the effect of the reorganization on the control of group assets, the final ownership structure, the relative voting power of existing shareholders if the share capital is being adjusted, and the expected benefits arising from the changes.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also assesses the proposed restructuring and its impact on job loss with an emphasis on the company’s U.S. operations. In certain circumstances, jobs may be lost due to economic inefficiencies. However, we will not support reorganizations that unnecessarily eradicate employment, harming the beneficiaries, communities, and the company’s economic position.

In the case of a distress restructuring of a company or group, shareholders’ options are far more limited; often, they have no choice but to approve the restructuring or lose everything. In such cases, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services first determines the company’s degree of distress by determining whether or not the company still has a positive net asset value — that is, if realizable assets are greater than liabilities. Although rare, liquidation should be considered an option in these situations.

In most cases, however, the company has a negative asset value, meaning that shareholders would have nothing left after a liquidation. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services seeks to ensure that the degree of dilution proposed is consistent with the claims of outside parties and is commensurate with the relative commitments of other company stakeholders. Existing shareholders usually must accept the transfer of majority control over the company to outside secured creditors. Ultimately, ownership of a small percentage of something is worth more than majority ownership of nothing.

MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS

For every M&A analysis, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews publicly available information as of the date of our analysis and evaluates the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors.

Vote CASE-BY-CASE on mergers and acquisitions taking into account the following:

 

   

Valuation — Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services places emphasis on the offer premium, market reaction, and strategic rationale;

 

   

Market reaction — How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction will elicit greater scrutiny on a deal;

 

   

Strategic rationale — Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions;

 

B-220


Table of Contents

 

   

Conflicts of interest — Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? We will consider whether any special interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger;

 

   

Governance — impact of the merger on and shareholder rights. Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance;

 

   

The possibility of a high degree of job loss with no reasonable explanation; and

 

   

Any significant reduction in basic labor standards.

Vote AGAINST if the companies do not provide sufficient information upon request to make an informed voting decision.

ABSTAIN if there is insufficient information available to make an informed voting decision.

Discussion

When evaluating the merits of a proposed acquisition, merger, or takeover offer, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services focuses on the financial and corporate governance impact on shareholder value, both in the immediate and long term. The primary concern is to determine whether or not the proposal is beneficial to shareholders’ existing and future earnings stream and to ensure that the impact on voting rights is not disproportionate to that benefit. Generally, we are interested in the long-term shareholder interests as opposed to short-term gains that devalue assets and have a negative impact on workers and communities.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will evaluate proposed mergers by looking at the justification for the merger; whether a reasonable financial arrangement has been proposed and a fairness opinion rendered; and the long-term impact of the business plans of the competing parties. We will assess the impact of the proposed merger on the affected workforce and community. For example, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will assess the proposed merger’s impact on job loss with an emphasis on the company’s U.S. operations. In certain circumstances, jobs may be lost due to economic inefficiencies. However, we will not support mergers that unnecessarily eradicate employment, harming the beneficiaries, and the company’s economic position.

In the case of a cross-border merger, we consider the proposed merger affect on labor standards. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will not support mergers that diminish basic labor standards. The resulting entity should comply with applicable laws and principles protecting employees’ wages, benefits, working conditions, freedom of association, and other rights.

In the case of an acquisition, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines the level of voting or earnings dilution and the logic of the proposed purchase if large share issuances are required. The method of financing is also important, as various methods can result in different valuations than originally perceived. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also checks for an independent valuation of the terms, particularly if the target of the acquisition is not a publicly traded entity or asset and precise market valuations are not readily available.

This is important when determining whether or not a specific premium is justified. Control premiums on acquisitions vary widely depending on the industry, the time period, and the country. During the late 1980s in the United States, control premiums of up to 70 percent in certain sectors were considered reasonable. Broad averages over time indicate that premiums in the range of 20 percent to 30 percent are normal, but this must be evaluated on a case-by-case basis. For publicly traded entities or assets, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks at the price of the acquisition relative to the average market price prior to any announcement, as well as the historical price trends for 60 days prior. For non-publicly traded entities or assets, an independent financial evaluation becomes even more important.

 

B-221


Table of Contents

 

In the case of mergers, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines whether or not the merger makes commercial or strategic sense for the company. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also considers the method of effecting the merger and the ultimate impact on shareholders of the proposed financial and corporate governance structure. While historical relative valuations based on market prices are useful in the financial evaluation process, the often-complicated financial details of such proposals make an independent fairness opinion of extreme importance. The proposed board structure, share capital structure, and relative share ownership of the new company are all important factors for consideration in this evaluation process.

If the details of a given proposal are unclear or not available and a fairness opinion is also not available, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will either abstain on or vote against the proposal. Abstention would most likely be the result of a lack of information about the proposal. If a company is uncooperative in providing information about the proposal or is evasive when responding to questions, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against it.

REINCORPORATION PROPOSALS

Vote reincorporation proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Discussion

Reincorporation proposals are most commonly seen in Canada, where companies may register under one of the provincial business statutes. However, companies in other countries may also seek shareholder approval to reincorporate in a U.S. state or another country. Many companies, including U.S. companies, choose to reincorporate in places such as Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, or the British Virgin Islands for tax purposes.

When examining a reincorporation proposal, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services first examines the reasons for the move. Sometimes a reincorporation proposal is part of a restructuring effort or merger agreement that contributes significantly to a company’s growth, financial health, and competitive position more than the anticipated negative consequences of incorporating in another province or country. Some reincorporations allow firms to realize lower taxes or incorporation fees. In addition, there may be advantages to incorporating in the province in which the company conducts the bulk of its business.

Companies often adopt a new charter or bylaws with increased protection for management upon reincorporation. For instance, many reincorporation proposals are bundled with the ratification of a new charter that increases the company’s capital stock or imposes a classified board. When such changes to the charter include the addition of negative corporate governance provisions, the impact of these new provisions on shareholders must be balanced against the anticipated benefits of the reincorporation.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that reincorporations to countries, states, or provinces with less stringent disclosure requirements or corporate governance provisions are often management attempts to lessen accountability to shareholders. In such cases, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote AGAINST the proposal. The expenses involved in a change of domicile relating to legal and administrative fees, plus the greater entrenchment such a reincorporation could provide management, would likely harm shareholders’ interests. In cases where companies propose to move to a more protective province or country and supply reasonable financial reasons for doing so, the benefits of the reincorporation must be weighed against the costs of possible management entrenchment.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also considers the reincorporation’s impact on the employment environment. We do not support reincorporations to new jurisdictions that diminish basic labor rights and standards.

 

B-222


Table of Contents

 

EXPANSION OF BUSINESS ACTIVITIES

Vote FOR resolutions to expand business activities unless the new business takes the company into risky areas.

Discussion

Companies are usually required by law to include in their articles of association or memorandum of association specific business purposes in the form of an objects clause. Because most countries require shareholder approval before articles can be amended, any change to the company’s objects clause requires shareholder approval. Countries often seek shareholder approval to amend the objects clause to expand business lines.

Expanding business lines is a decision usually best left to management, but there are some instances where Taft-Hartley Advisory Services withholds support for such changes. If a company has performed poorly for several years and seeks business expansion into a risky enterprise, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services would require further clarification from management regarding the purpose of the expansion. If the company does not provide a satisfactory business plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will not support the proposal. Furthermore, if the company does not adhere to basic labor principles or codes of conduct in the expansion of its business, then Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will not support the proposal. For example, the expansion must comply with applicable laws and regulations, provide legitimate policies regarding workplace health and safety, and recognize basic labor rights. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that these policies and practices affect long-term corporate performance and increase shareholder value.

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, resolutions that seek shareholder approval on related party transactions considering factors including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

The parties on either side of the transaction;

 

   

The nature of the asset to be transferred/service to be provided; the pricing of the transaction (and any associated professional valuation);

 

   

The views of independent directors (where provided);

 

   

The views of an independent financial adviser (where appointed);

 

   

Whether any entities party to the transaction (including advisers) is conflicted; and

 

   

The stated rationale for the transaction, including discussions of timing.

If there is a transaction that RMG deemed problematic and that was not put to a shareholder vote, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services may vote against the election of the director involved in the related-party transaction or the full board.

Vote AGAINST related party transactions when details of a particular arrangement are not available.

Discussion

Shareholders are often asked to approve commercial transactions between related parties. A transaction between a parent company and its subsidiary, or a company’s dealings with entities that employ the company’s directors, are usually classified as related party transactions and are subject to company law or stock exchange listing requirements that mandate shareholder approval. Shareholder approval of these transactions is meant to protect shareholders against insider trading abuses.

 

B-223


Table of Contents

 

In most cases, both the rationale and terms of such transactions are reasonable. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services looks for evidence of an evaluation of the transaction by an independent body, but this is not always available. Unless the agreement requests a strategic move outside the company’s charter or contains unfavorable terms, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support the proposal. However, in many countries, detailed information about related-party transactions is not available. In some cases, no information is available. When sufficient information is not available, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote AGAINST the arrangement.

COMPENSATION PLANS

Vote AGAINST a company’s compensation-related proposal due to one or a combination of several of the following factors:

 

   

The proposed compensation policy/report was not made available to shareholders in a timely manner;

 

   

The level of disclosure of the proposed compensation policy is below what local market best practice standards dictate;

 

   

Concerns exist with respect to the disclosure or structure of the bonus or other aspects of the remuneration policy such as pensions, severance terms, and discretionary payments;

 

   

Concerns exist surrounding the company’s long-term incentive plan(s), including but not limited to, dilution, vesting period, and performance conditions; Excessive severance arrangements/payments;

 

   

Provision of stock option grants, or similarly structured equity-based compensation, to non-executive directors; and/or

 

   

Where boards have, otherwise, failed to demonstrate good stewardship of investors’ interests regarding executive compensation practices.

Vote AGAINST other appropriate resolutions as a measure of discontent against egregious remuneration practices (as a result of one or a combination of several factors highlighted above) or where a company has not followed market practice by submitting a resolution on executive compensation.

A negative vote could be applied to any of the following resolutions on a case-by case basis:

 

   

The (re)election of members of the remuneration committee;

 

   

The discharge of directors; or

 

   

The annual report and accounts.

Failure to propose a resolution on executive compensation to shareholders in a market where this is routine practice may, by itself, lead to one of the above adverse votes regardless of the companies’ remuneration practices.

Management Proposals Seeking Shareholder Approval of the Company’s Compensation Policy (Say on Pay)

Vote on a CASE-By-CASE basis, management proposals seeking ratification of a company’s compensation policy.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that seeking annual shareholder approval of a company’s compensation policy is a positive corporate governance provision, and considers the following compensation best practices in evaluating shareholder votes on corporate compensation practices:

 

   

Appropriate pay-for-performance alignment with emphasis on long-term shareholder value.

 

   

Avoidance of arrangements that risk “pay for failure”.

 

B-224


Table of Contents

 

   

Independent and effective compensation committees.

 

   

Provision of clear and comprehensive compensation disclosures to shareholders.

 

   

Avoidance of inappropriate pay to non-executive directors.

Non-Executive Director Compensation

Vote FOR proposals to award cash fees to non-executive directors unless the amounts are excessive relative to other companies in the country or industry.

Vote on non-executive director compensation proposals that include both cash and share-based components on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote on proposals that bundle compensation for both non-executive and executive directors into a single resolution on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote AGAINST proposals to introduce retirement benefits for non-executive directors.

Vote AGAINST non-executive director remuneration if documents (general meeting documents, annual report) provided prior to the general meeting do not mention fees paid to non-executive directors.

Vote AGAINST non-executive director remuneration if the company intends to excessively increase the fees in comparison with market/sector practices, without stating compelling reasons that justify the increase.

Vote AGAINST proposals that provide for the granting of stock options, or similarly structured equity-based compensation, to non-executive directors.

Discussion

The recent financial crisis has shown that poor remuneration systems can lead to the inefficient allocation of company resources and can incentivize behavior that is detrimental to long-term shareholder interests. More than ever, shareholders have become concerned with how companies compensate their executives. Scrutiny has been applied to ascertain whether executive pay is appropriate for a company’s size, market, and industry, and whether remuneration structures sufficiently incentivize long-term share value growth and avoid “pay for failure”. In response to this growing trend, many legislatures/regulators have taken steps to strengthen shareholders’ role in the determination of remuneration practices by increasing companies’ disclosure requirements with respect to compensation practices as well as by recommending (or requiring) that companies provide voting resolutions on remuneration practices at their annual shareholder meetings.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports plans that motivate participants to focus on maximizing long-term shareholder value and returns, encourage employee stock ownership, and more closely align employee interests with those of shareholders. However, we recognize that in many markets, the degree of information available to evaluate compensation proposals is usually limited in detail. For this reason, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services applies its compensation policies and methodology to the extent that market disclosure practices allow.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews three main types of compensation plans: stock option plans, incentive plans, and share purchase plans. Also included in this section are grants outside of plans.

Stock Option Plans

Stock option plans grant participants an option to buy company shares at a set price (the exercise price). Shares are usually granted at market prices and may be exercised when the company’s share price reaches the exercise price. Participants may then purchase the promised shares at the strike price and may later sell the shares

 

B-225


Table of Contents

after their purchase (or after a defined holding period when the shares may not be sold). Among the criteria that Taft-Hartley Advisory Services examines in evaluating stock option plans are the following, generally organized from criteria of greater importance to criteria of lesser importance:

Shares Reserved for Issuance of Options Under the Plan

The maximum number of shares Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves under a plan depends on the classification of a company’s stage of development as growth or mature. Growth companies are usually smaller, in new industries requiring significant research and development, and have restricted cash flows. A company in an established industry but expanding rapidly, or a mature company that is experiencing an extended period of rapid expansion, may also be classified as growth. Mature companies are characterized by stable sales and revenue growth, production efficiencies resulting from volume gains, and strong cash flow resulting from developed products in the payoff stage.

For mature companies, shares available under stock option plans should be no more than five percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans. For growth companies, shares available should be no more than ten percent of the issued capital at the time of approval under all plans (and five percent under the proposed plan.) For all companies, an absolute number of shares fixed at the time of approval is ideal, but many countries do not include such a limit. In these cases, revolving limits (a certain percentage of issued shares at any one time) of five or ten percent are common. The practice of setting a percentage of shares issuable over a certain number of years before or after the plan is adopted appears to be a compromise between these first two methods. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers plans where the limits are sufficiently spread out, e.g., five percent in five years, ten percent in ten years.

Exercise Price

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that options be priced at 100 percent of the shares’ fair market value on the date of grant. Usually this is taken as the closing price of the company’s shares on the day prior to the date of grant. Some countries determine fair market value as an average of the trading price for the five days prior to the date of grant. This is a common and acceptable practice. Some emerging market countries use a 30-day average or longer to determine fair market value; these resolutions must be reviewed on a case-by-case basis, although provisions of longer than 30 days increase the possibility of discounted options.

Exercise Price Discounts

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services strongly opposes grants of discounted options to both executive and nonexecutive directors. In the absence of vesting periods or performance criteria (see below), discounted option grants to directors amount to a cash bonus at shareholder expense. Under such circumstances, option holders have an incentive to cash in their grants for an immediate return rather than hold on to their options for future gains. This undermines the incentive value underlining these plans. A few countries allow for options to be granted at a discount to market prices. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves of discounts up to 20 percent, but only for grants that are a part of a broad-based employee plan, including all nonexecutive employees.

Plan Administration

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes allowing the administering committee to grant options to itself due to the potential for “backscratching” abuse. Administration of plans should be in the hands of directors who are unable to participate in the plan. Plans administered by the full board should not allow voting by executive directors; plans administered by remuneration committees should be composed entirely of independent directors. Plans that allow nonexecutive directors to participate should not give them any discretion on individual grants; instead, an automatic system of grants should be introduced with fixed annual grants at market prices on a fixed date. Alternatively, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves of separate nonexecutive director option plans with independent administration.

 

B-226


Table of Contents

 

Eligibility and Participation

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers separate plans for employees, directors, and nonexecutive directors, but most plans include all or some combination of these categories of participants. Other global plans distinguish between full-time and part-time employees or establish a set length of service to the company (usually one year) before options may be granted. Most plans allow the administrating committee to select plan participants.

Performance Criteria and Vesting Provisions

Performance criteria and vesting provisions are important considerations when evaluating a compensation plan, and the existence of long vesting provisions and realistic performance criteria are highly preferred. The ultimate goal of share option plans is to tie executive and employee remuneration to company performance and to give key employees and executives incentive to stay with the firm. Generally in markets where disclosure is an issue, if a plan meets all other aspects of Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ guidelines, these two criteria are not mandatory. However, whenever greater disclosure is the market norm, we will oppose plans that do not include sufficiently challenging performance criteria or carry a minimum three-year vesting period. This information is commonly provided in markets such as the United Kingdom, Canada, The Netherlands and Australia. Finally, any matching shares that are provided by companies should be subject to additional performance conditions.

Retesting of Performance Criteria

Remuneration plans should not allow for the retesting of performance criteria over another time period if these conditions were not met within the initial period. Retesting is destructive to the incentive value of such plans and undermines the worth of performance criteria. Whenever disclosure is sufficient enough to determine if retesting is allowed under a company’s plan, we will take this feature into consideration for our overall evaluation of the plan.

 

Market Specifics:

 

•   In the UK, whether the terms of a compensation plan are to be satisfied by the issuance of new shares or through the use of treasury shares, the maximum commitment of the aggregate awards under all of the company’s plans should not exceed 10% of issued ordinary capital over a rolling 10-year period for broad-based plans. Within these limits, awards for discretionary plans should not exceed 5% for a rolling 10-year period.

 

Other Features Specific to Option Plans

Issue Terms

Some countries require optionees to pay a nominal fee (often equivalent to $0.01) for every option received. This is common and acceptable, although many companies that once enforced this provision are now deleting it from the rules of their plans.

Option Repricing

Some plans include specific provisions allowing for the repricing of options at the board’s discretion. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes plans that include option repricing when the exercise price is reduced in response to a dropping share price. Repricing outstanding options reduces the incentive that options provide to raise the share price for shareholders.

Financial Assistance

Some plans offer participants loans to pay the full exercise price on their options. If loans are part of a company’s option plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a

 

B-227


Table of Contents

broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessary warrant a recommendation against an option plan, but they are taken into consideration in Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ analysis of the plan.

Plans for International Employees

Many overseas companies introduce separate plans or delegate a special section of their option plan to deal with tax considerations raised by having a large number of employees working in other countries. Many of these plans contain provisions that deal directly with particular U.S. tax code provisions on stock options. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services applies the same criteria to these plans as to country-specific plans.

Stock Appreciation Rights

Stock appreciation rights (SARs) allow participants to receive the difference between the exercise price and the market price at the date of exercise. Many companies use SARs in lieu of regular options. While SARs do not result in the dilution associated with large option exercises, there is little difference between an SAR and a regular option from a shareholder perspective because the financial cost to the company is the same. However, SARs do not encourage stock ownership by participants because they involve no purchase or sale of company stock. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews SARs in the context of the option plan under which they are issued.

Phantom Stock Option Plans

Phantom stock options offer participants cash bonuses based on the increase in share price during a set period of time. Phantom plans are distinct from SARs in that they often form their own separate plan. Some companies will create a phantom stock option plan to award employees who reside in countries that do not allow stock-based compensation. Participants are designated a set number of hypothetical (phantom) shares, on which the award is based. While Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers compensation plans that encourage employee ownership, SARs and phantom options are an effective way to provide incentive.

Super Options

Super options exceed the limits in a particular country for the value of options granted to any one individual, although they are usually tied to significantly more restrictive vesting provisions and performance criteria. U.K. super options, for example, exceed the Association of British Insurers’ recommended limit that options represent no more than four times a participant’s salary, yet the stricter performance criteria and longer vesting periods usually mitigate excessive grants. Additionally, dilution resulting from super options has historically been fairly moderate. Super options appear most often in advanced markets with developed stock option plans.

Restricted Stock

Restricted stock is specifically designated stock offered at a discount to executives, often under U.S. option plans but increasingly among overseas plans as well. Company shares may be granted outright to optionees with no payment required for the receipt of the shares. Such awards can be extremely expensive, as participants exercise awards at fixed prices far below the current market price. If restricted stock is included as part of a stock option plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services expects strict limits on the amount of shares that may be issued in this form.

Dividends Under Option and Dividend Equivalent Payment Provisions

Most holders of stock options do not receive dividend payments. However, some option plans allow participants to receive dividends or dividend equivalent payments prior to the exercise of options. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services believes that any economic benefit derived from option plans should occur at the time of exercise.

 

B-228


Table of Contents

 

Incentive Plans

Share incentive plans tie key employees’ compensation more directly to company performance. Though most popular in the United Kingdom, incentive plans are becoming increasingly popular across the globe. Incentive plans provide participants with free grants of company shares (or, less frequently, cash grants) in proportion with prearranged performance criteria—often earnings per share measured against inflation or total shareholder return. These indicators are frequently compared with those of other firms in the company’s industry or stock market index, creating a benchmark and a further determinant of the number of shares granted to a particular participant. Proponents of incentive plans note that they offer shareholders the potential for less dilution and that they more directly encourage participants to focus on long-term company performance through strict performance criteria tied to more than just share price movements.

Most incentive plans are organized with strict vesting provisions, where participants may not receive the share awards until after a period of three years or more. Many plans also grant a percentage of the total amount reserved for each participant on a sliding scale measured against performance criteria. Performance criteria targets that have been satisfied only to a certain point may represent disbursement of 25 percent of the shares or cash to a participant, while 100-percent satisfaction may represent the full allotment of the grant. From a shareholder perspective, this graduated system of performance criteria is a major advance.

Evaluation of incentive plans is similar to that of option plans in that acceptable dilution and impartial administration and eligibility remain key factors for a positive recommendation. Insufficient performance criteria or abbreviated vesting provisions are deciding factors as well.

Share Purchase Plans

Share purchase plans allow participants to purchase shares in the company, often at a discount to market prices. These plans are often broad-based in nature, as they are usually open to all employees. Other plans operate via monthly deductions from employees’ paychecks, gathered and held for safe keeping by a trust or a bank and used every month or year to purchase company stock.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will approve many of these plans because they encourage wide share ownership in the company among employees. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services generally approves broad-based, employee-directed share purchase plans with discounts up to 20 percent. Dilution, eligibility, and administration are the key factors in determining Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ recommendation

Other Features Specific to Share Purchase Plans

Eligibility

While eligibility under share purchase plans is evaluated similarly to stock option plans, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services affords more flexibility with the terms of broad-based employee purchase plans. The inclusion of permanent part-time employees and employees who have been with the company for less than one year are provisions of employee plans that are routinely approved.

Loan Terms

Some plans offer participants loans to pay for the shares. If loans are part of a share purchase plan, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that loans be made to employees as part of a broad-based, company-wide plan to encourage ownership rather than being given only to executive directors. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also prefers loans with interest set at market rates that must be paid back in full over a reasonable length of time. The absence of these features does not necessary warrant a recommendation against a share purchase plan, but they are taken into consideration in Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ analysis of the plan.

 

B-229


Table of Contents

 

Grants Outside of Plans

Resolutions asking shareholders to approve specific grants of shares or cash outside of established plans are problematic. Some companies prefer not to adopt formal share plans, instead asking shareholders to approve yearly grants to specific employees. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services prefers that companies make such grants in the context of an established plan.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ primary concern with grants outside of plans is the level of dilution they afford. The number of shares issued as part of the grants, when combined with the number of shares reserved for the company’s other share plans, must fall within acceptable dilution limits. Vesting provisions and performance criteria are also important and are evaluated on the same basis as if the grants were part of a formal plan.

ANTITAKEOVER MECHANISMS

Vote AGAINST all antitakeover proposals unless they are structured in such a way that they give shareholders the ultimate decision on any proposal or offer.

Discussion

Common antitakeover mechanisms include staggered boards, super-voting shares, poison pills, unlimited authorized capital authorizations (including blank check preferred stock), and golden shares. Some of these restrictions are aimed solely at limiting share ownership by foreign or unwanted minority shareholders, and others are designed to preclude an unwanted takeover of the target company by any party. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services opposes all forms of such mechanisms, as they limit shareholder value by eliminating the takeover or control premium for the company. As owners of the company, shareholders should be given the opportunity to decide on the merits of takeover offers.

Renew Partial Takeover Provision (Australia)

Australian law allows companies to introduce into their articles a provision to protect shareholders from partial takeover offers, to be renewed by shareholders every three years. If a partial takeover of the company is announced, directors are required to convene a shareholder meeting at least 15 days before the closing of the offer to seek approval of the offer. If shareholders reject the resolution, the offer is considered withdrawn under company law and the company can refuse to register the shares tendered to the offer. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services approves of consulting shareholders on takeover offers, and this article provides protection for minority shareholders by giving them ultimate decision-making authority based on their own interests, not the interests of directors or outside parties. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the adoption of this proposal in almost all cases.

Golden Shares

Recently privatized companies across the world often include in their share structure a golden share held by their respective governments. These shares often carry special voting rights or the power of automatic veto over specific proposals. Golden shares are most common among former state-owned companies or politically sensitive industries such as utilities, railways, and airlines. While the introduction of golden shares is not a desirable governance practice, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services recognizes the political importance certain companies hold for governments and treats the introduction or amendment of government shares on a case-by-case basis.

Poison Pills (Canada, Japan)

Otherwise known as shareholder rights plans, poison pills are seen primarily in the Canadian and Japanese markets. Companies generally state that they seek to adopt or renew pills in order to protect shareholders against unfair, abusive, or coercive takeover strategies and to give the target company’s board time to pursue alternatives to a hostile takeover bid. Theoretically, the board will refuse to redeem the pill in the face of an unfair offer in order to force a bidder to negotiate for a better offer, at which point it will redeem the pill.

 

B-230


Table of Contents

 

In accomplishing these goals, however, many rights plans place too much of the decision-making powers in the hands of the board and management and out of the hands of shareholders. However, we note that many Canadian companies have adopted new shareholder rights plans that address the concerns of institutional investors, namely providing for three-year sunset provisions, allowing for partial bids to proceed despite board opposition, and curtailing the overall level of discretion afforded the board in interpreting the pills.

Nonetheless, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services guidelines generally do not support the adoption of poison pills on the grounds that they serve to entrench management. Improperly structured rights plans have been used by boards to ward off offers beneficial to shareholders. Current owners should decide who will own the company, with advice and negotiation from the board and management. When considering the merits of a poison pill, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services also examines what other antitakeover devices the company has and the company’s treatment of shareholders in past situations.

Poison pills often have a sunset provision, which requires shareholder confirmation of the plan. Most pills have either a three-year or a five-year sunset provision, requiring that shareholders confirm the continuation of the plan three or five years from the date of adoption. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services guidelines support a three-year sunset provision, which affords shareholders the ability to reconsider the plan in light of changing market conditions and to review management’s use of the plan. Canadian pills also typically include of a permitted bid clause, under which the takeover bid must be made on equal terms to all holders of the company’s voting shares; the company must extend the expiration of the bid, usually by 45 or 60 days following the date of the bid. Management sets the terms of the permitted bid clause, and therefore it influences the level of protection that will be provided to shareholders.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services determines whether the permitted bid feature offers shareholders adequate powers relative to the board in the event of a bid not being approved by the board. Allowing shareholders the right to override the board as a means of balancing power is crucial, but the specifics of the permitted bid clause are usually insufficient. Under the clause, a shareholder who is not intent on a complete acquisition but merely wishes to purchase a significant stake in the company may trigger the pill. This gives the board power to deny shareholders the benefit of a large semi-controlling shareholder and precludes partial bids that may be in shareholders’ interests. In addition to the sunset provision and the structure of the permitted bid clause, in order to qualify for approval, a shareholder rights plan must satisfy ALL of the following conditions:

 

   

Permitted bid clause structure: a permitted bid clause must allow for partial bids supported by a majority of shareholders to proceed despite board opposition; bid periods should generally not be greater than 60 days; the clause” should not contain a “toehold provision” that would any person who already controls a specified percentage of shares from making a permitted bid;

 

   

Amendments: the ability of the board to amend key terms of the plan without shareholder approval following initial adoption of the plan must be limited to clerical and typographical changes and changes required to maintain the validity of the rights plan;

 

   

Exchange option: a plan must not contain a provision that would enable the board to issue in exchange for the right, with or without further charge, debt or equity securities, other assets of the company, or any combination thereof;

 

   

Definition of Fair Market Value: the board must not have the discretion to interpret the fair market value of the company’s shares if the board determines that the value was adversely affected by the news of an anticipated or actual bid or by other means of manipulation;

 

   

Affiliates and Associates: the board’s discretion to decide which parties are acting in concert to determine the level of beneficial ownership, which could be used to trigger the pill should be limited and well-defined in the text of the plan;

 

   

Mandatory Waiver: if the board waives the triggering of the pill with respect to one bidder, the board must be required to waive the pill in favor of any subsequent bids, preventing the board from favoring one bid over another regardless of shareholder interests.

 

B-231


Table of Contents

 

Since 2006, the vast majority of Japanese poison pills have been so called “advance warning-type” (“advance notice-type”) defense plans. In these cases, the board announces in advance a set of disclosure requirements it expects any bidder to comply with, as well as a waiting period between the submission of this information and the launch of the bid. As long as the bidder complies with these rules, the company “in principle” will take no action to block the bid, but will allow shareholders to decide.

The exceptions are where the bid is judged to be clearly detrimental to shareholders, such as in situations defined by a Japanese court or in a report of the government’s Corporate Value Study Group. These include greenmail, asset stripping and coercive two-tier offers. Usually, such judgments are made by a “special committee” or “independent committee,” but the committee’s decision is usually subject to being overruled by the board. At some companies the decisions are made by the board with no committee input at all. Advance warning-type defenses do not require shareholder approval, although in most cases companies are choosing to put them to a shareholder vote, as it is believed that doing so will put the company in a stronger position in the event of a lawsuit.

Where a company implements an advance warning-type defense without a shareholder vote, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will similarly examine the details of the plan, and where we deem it to be detrimental to shareholder value, we will consider recommending votes against the company’s representative director(s).

Depositary Receipts and Priority Shares (The Netherlands)

Depositary receipts are an especially common antitakeover defense among large Dutch companies. In the event of a hostile takeover bid, ordinary voting shares are first issued to a company-friendly trust or foundation. The trust or foundation in turn issues depositary receipts, similar to banks in the United States issuing ADRs except that the foundation retains the voting rights of the issued security. The depositary receipts carry only the financial rights attached to the shares (i.e., dividends). In this manner, the company gains access to capital while retaining control over voting rights. Nonvoting preference shares can be issued to trusts or foundations in a similar fashion.

Priority shares, established in a company’s articles, may be awarded with certain powers of control over the rest of the company. In practice, priority shares are held by members of the supervisory board, company-friendly trusts or foundations, or other friendly parties. Depending on the articles, priority shareholders may determine the size of the management or supervisory boards or may propose amendments to articles and the dissolution of the company. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote against the introduction of depositary receipts and priority shares.

SHAREHOLDER PROPOSALS

Vote all shareholder proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

Vote FOR proposals that would improve the company’s corporate governance or business profile at a reasonable cost.

Vote AGAINST proposals that limit the company’s business activities or capabilities or result in significant costs being incurred with little or no benefit.

Discussion

Unlike in the United States where shareholders proposals are quite common, they are less common overseas. One market where proposals sponsored by shareholders are more common is the German market. There are two types of such proposals—shareholder proposals and counterproposals. Counterproposals are filed in direct

 

B-232


Table of Contents

opposition to proposals put forward by management at a given shareholder meeting. Many shareholder and counterproposals in Germany focus on environmental and labor issues. The number of shareholder proposals is also on the rise in Canada, although the aggregate annual number still pales in comparison to the U.S. In general shareholder proposals seen at global companies cover a wide variety of issues, including fundamental corporate governance topics, social issues, direct action proposals, as well as many unique proposals.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ position on the issues covered in many of these proposals has already been discussed. Generally, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will evaluate shareholder proposals to determine whether they are in the best economic interests of the participants and beneficiaries we represent. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ clients, not Taft-Hartley Advisory Services, choose the companies in which they invest and, ultimately, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services’ responsibility is to protect their economic interests. This does not mean, though, that Taft-Hartley Advisory Services must take a short-term approach when evaluating these proposals. Rather, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will vote in consistency with the economic best interests of the participants and beneficiaries.

In general, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports proposals that request the company to furnish information helpful to shareholders in evaluating the company’s operations. In order to intelligently monitor their investments, shareholders often need information best provided by the company in which they have invested. Requests to report such information merit support. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will evaluate proposals seeking the company to cease taking certain actions that the proponent believes is harmful to society or some segment of society with special attention to the company’s legal and ethical obligations, its ability to remain profitable, and potential negative publicity if the company fails to honor the request.

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services reviews all shareholder proposals to ascertain whether the proposal is beneficial or detrimental to shareholder value. Most resolutions fall into three basic categories: corporate governance, social, and environmental. While shareholder proposals in most countries are not as prevalent as they are in the United States, they are becoming more common, and standards for reviewing the various types of proposals are necessary.

Corporate Governance Proposals

Corporate governance-related proposals must be evaluated carefully because any changes can dramatically affect shareholder value. Support for such proposals must be measured against the likely impact that approval would have on the company’s operations. If a measure would improve disclosure of company activities in nonstrategic areas and at minimal costs, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services supports the proposal. If a proposal seeks to improve the company’s corporate governance structure, such as adopting board committees, eliminating staggered board structures, or canceling antitakeover instruments, approval is also warranted. However, if acceptance of a proposal is likely to lead to a disruption in board or management operations and to cause the company to incur significant costs without clear benefit, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will oppose the proposal.

Social and Environmental Proposals

The voting fiduciary should support social and environmental proposals if they either contribute to the long term interests of plan participants and beneficiaries, or will have no adverse impact on plan participants and beneficiaries.

Global codes of conduct for social, human, and economic standards are an important component in the stability of world economic conditions and in protecting the current lifestyle of plan beneficiaries and participants. Without agreement on international codes, some international companies could pursue a race to the bottom strategy that could ultimately undermine U.S. environmental and economic conditions.

 

B-233


Table of Contents

 

Report on Environmental Policies

These resolutions request the company to disclose its environmental practices. For example, Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support proposals calling for a report on hazardous waste policies and issues regarding Maquiladora factories in Mexico.

Adoption of “CERES Principles”

These resolutions call for the adoption of principles that encourage the company to protect the environment and the safety and health of its employees. Many companies have voluntarily adopted these principles. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support these proposals as they often improve the company’s public image, reduce exposure to liabilities, and establish standards so that environmentally responsible companies and markets are not at a competitive financial disadvantage.

Adoption of “MacBride Principles”

These resolutions call for the adoption of the MacBride Principles for operations located in Northern Ireland. They request companies operating abroad to support the equal employment opportunity policies that apply in facilities they operate domestically. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will support such proposals as an appropriate obligation for the company to undertake.

Contract Supplier Standards

These resolutions call for compliance with governmental mandates and corporate policies regarding nondiscrimination, affirmative action, work place safety and health and other basic labor protections. Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support proposals that:

 

   

seek publication of a “Code of Conduct” to the company’s foreign suppliers and licensees, requiring they satisfy all applicable standards and laws protecting employees’ wages, benefits, working conditions, freedom of association, and other rights.

 

   

request a report summarizing the company’s current practices for enforcement of its Code of Conduct.

 

   

establishes independent monitoring programs in conjunction with local and respected religious and human rights groups to monitor supplier and licensee compliance with the Code of Conduct.

 

   

create incentives to encourage suppliers to raise standards rather than terminate contracts.

 

   

implement policies for ongoing wage adjustments, ensuring adequate purchasing power and a sustainable living wage for employees of foreign suppliers and licensees.

 

   

request public disclosure of contract supplier reviews on a regular basis.

Corporate Conduct and Human Rights

Taft-Hartley Advisory Services will generally support proposals that call for the adoption and/or enforcement of principles or codes relating to countries in which there are systematic violations of human rights; such as the use of slave, child, or prison labor; a government that is illegitimate; or there is a call by human rights advocates, pro-democracy organizations, or legitimately-elected representatives for economic sanctions.

 

B-234


Table of Contents

 

SCHEDULE C

Proxy Vote Override/Decision Form

Portfolio Manager Requesting Override/Making Decision:

 

 

Portfolio Management Product Area (check one):

 

¨ Growth         
¨ Value    ¨ International Equity    ¨ Convertible   
¨ Fixed (High Yield)    ¨ Fixed (High Grade)      

Security Issuer:

 

 

Security’s exchange ticker symbol:

 

 

Cusip #:

 

 

# of Shares held/par amount held:

 

 

Percentage of outstanding shares/par amount held:

 

 

Type of accounts holding security: Mutual Funds (name each fund):                                                                          

Separate Accounts (specify number):                                                                                                            

Other (describe):                                                                                                                                             

Applicable Guidelines (check one):

¨ MacKay Standard (A or B)

¨ Other (specify):

¨ N/A

Shareholder/Bondholder/Lender Meeting Date:

 

 

Response Deadline:

 

 

Brief Description of the Matter to be Voted On:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proposal Type (check one):

¨ Management Proposal

¨ Shareholder Proposal (identify proponent:                                                                                            )

 

Recommended vote by issuer’s management (check one):    ¨ For    ¨ Against    ¨ N/A

 

B-235


Table of Contents
Recommended vote by ISS (check one):    ¨ For    ¨ Against
   ¨ Abstain    ¨ N/A
   ¨ No Recommendation   
Portfolio manager recommended vote (check one):    ¨ For    ¨ Against
   ¨ Abstain   

Describe in detail why you believe this override/decision is in the client’s best interest (attach supporting documentation):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the issuer, or its officers or directors, and MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the issuer, including its officers or directors, and any executive officers of MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the proponent of the proxy proposal (if not the issuer) and MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

B-236


Table of Contents

 

Are you aware of any relationship between the proponent of the proxy proposal (if not the issuer) and any executive officers of MacKay Shields or any of its affiliates?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Has anyone (outside of your portfolio management area) contacted you in an attempt to influence your decision to vote this proxy matter?

¨ No        ¨ Yes

If yes, please describe below who contacted you and on whose behalf, the manner in which you were contacted (such as by phone, by mail, as part of group, individually etc.), the subject matter of the communication and any other relevant information, and attach copies of any written communications.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Are you aware of any facts related to this proxy vote that may present a potential conflict of interest with the interests of the client(s) on whose behalf the proxies are to be voted?

¨ No        ¨ Yes (describe below)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Certification:

The undersigned hereby certifies that to the best of his or her knowledge, the above statements are complete and accurate, and that such override/decision is in the client(s)’ best interests without regard to the interests of MacKay Shields or any related parties.

 

Date:

  

 

Name:

  

 

Title:

  

 

 

B-237


Table of Contents

 

Product Head Concurrence with Override Request/Decision:

 

Date:

  

 

Name:

  

 

Title:

  

 

Legal/Compliance Action:

¨ Override/decision approved

¨ Referred to Compliance Committee for Further Consideration

 

Date:

  

 

Name:

  

 

Title:

  

 

 

B-238


Table of Contents

 

MARSICO CAPITAL MANAGEMENT, LLC

PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES

Statement of Policy

1. It is the policy of Marsico Capital Management, LLC (“MCM”) to seek to vote or otherwise process, such as by a decision to abstain from voting or to take no action on, proxies over which it has voting authority in the best interests of MCM’s clients, as summarized here.

 

   

MCM’s security analysts generally review proxy proposals as part of their monitoring of portfolio companies. Under MCM’s investment discipline, one of the qualities that MCM generally seeks in companies selected for client portfolios is good management teams that generally seek to serve shareholder interests. Because MCM believes that the management teams of most companies it invests in generally seek to serve shareholder interests, MCM believes that voting proxy proposals in clients’ best economic interests usually means voting with the recommendations of these management teams (including their boards of directors).

 

   

In certain circumstances, MCM’s vote-by-vote analysis of proxy proposals could lead it to conclude that particular management or board recommendations may not appear as closely aligned with shareholder interests as MCM may deem desirable, or could be disregarded in the best interests of shareholders. In those and other circumstances, MCM may, in its sole discretion, vote against a management or board recommendation (or abstain or take no action) based on its analysis if such a vote appears consistent with the best interests of clients.

 

   

MCM may process certain proxies without voting them, such as by making a decision to abstain from voting or take no action on such proxies (or on certain proposals within such proxies). Examples include, without limitation, proxies issued by companies that MCM has decided to sell, proxies issued for securities that MCM did not select for a client portfolio (such as, without limitation, securities that were selected by a previous adviser, unsupervised securities held in a client’s account, money market securities, or other securities selected by clients or their representatives other than MCM), or proxies issued by foreign companies that impose burdensome or unreasonable voting, power of attorney, or holding requirements. MCM also may abstain from voting, or take no action on, proxies in other circumstances, such as when voting may not be in the best interests of clients, as an alternative to voting with (or against) management, or when voting may be unduly burdensome or expensive, or if MCM may have a material conflict of interest in voting certain proxies and alternative voting procedures are not desirable.

 

   

In circumstances when there may be an apparent material conflict of interest between MCM’s interests and clients’ interests in how proxies are voted (such as when MCM knows that a proxy issuer is also an MCM client), MCM generally will resolve any appearance concerns by causing those proxies to be “echo voted” or “mirror voted” in the same proportion as other votes, by voting the proxies as recommended by an independent service provider, or by abstaining or taking no action. In other cases, MCM might use other procedures to resolve an apparent material conflict.

 

   

MCM may use an independent service provider to assist in voting proxies, keep voting records, and disclose voting information to clients. MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and reports describing the voting of a client’s proxies are available to the client on request.

 

   

MCM seeks to ensure that, to the extent reasonably feasible, proxies for which MCM receives ballots in good order and receives timely notice will be voted or otherwise processed (such as through a decision to abstain or take no action) as intended under MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and procedures. MCM may be unable to vote or otherwise process proxy ballots that are not received or processed in a timely manner due to functional limitations of the proxy voting system, custodial limitations, or other factors beyond MCM’s control. Such ballots may include, without limitation, ballots for securities out on loan under securities lending programs initiated by the client or its custodian, ballots not timely

 

B-239


Table of Contents
 

forwarded by a custodian, or ballots for which MCM does not timely receive essential information such as the proxy proposal itself or modifications to the required voting date. Other ballots may be voted but not counted, or may be counted in an unexpected way, because of factors such as foreign voting requirements or other limitations.

Definitions

2. By “best interests of MCM’s clients,” MCM means clients’ best economic interests over the long term – that is, the common interest that all clients share in seeing the value of a common investment increase over time. Clients may have differing political or social interests, but their best economic interests are generally uniform.

3. By “material conflict of interest,” MCM means circumstances when MCM itself knowingly does business with a particular proxy issuer, other principal proponent of a proposal, or an entity closely affiliated with the proxy issuer or other principal proponent of a proposal, or other circumstances in which MCM may appear to have a significant conflict of interest between its own interests and the interests of clients in how proxies are voted.

Procedures: MCM Invests in Companies With Management Teams That Seek Shareholders’ Best Interests, and Usually Votes Proxies with Management Recommendations

4. MCM’s security analysts generally review proxy proposals as part of their monitoring of portfolio companies. Under MCM’s investment discipline, one of the qualities that MCM generally seeks in companies selected for client portfolios is good management teams that generally seek to serve shareholder interests. Because MCM believes that the management teams of companies it invests in generally seek to serve shareholder interests, MCM believes that voting proxy proposals in clients’ best economic interests usually means voting with the recommendations of these management teams (or their boards of directors). Therefore, when portfolio companies issue proxy proposals, MCM usually votes the proxies with management or board recommendations, because it believes that recommendations by these companies’ managements generally are in shareholders’ best interests, and therefore in the best economic interests of MCM’s clients.

5. In certain circumstances, MCM’s vote-by-vote analysis of proxy proposals could lead it to conclude that particular management or board recommendations may not appear as closely aligned with shareholder interests as MCM may deem desirable, or could be disregarded in the best interests of shareholders. For example, in some circumstances, certain proxy proposals or recommendations by management, shareholders, or other proponents – such as, without limitation, proposals that would affect corporate governance relating to anti-takeover measures, board election requirements, director qualifications, shared board and management responsibilities, capitalization changes, compensation programs, or other matters – could present circumstances in which management recommendations may not appear as closely aligned with shareholder interests as MCM in its sole discretion may deem desirable. In those and other circumstances, MCM may, in its sole discretion, vote against a management or board recommendation (or abstain or take no action) based on MCM’s analysis if in MCM’s view such a vote appears consistent with the best interests of clients. As further examples, in MCM’s sole discretion, it may vote against a management or board recommendation in order to, without limitation, support a shareholder proposal favoring safeguards against potential overreaching by management or enhancements of shareholder control that MCM believes are reasonable or appropriate, or vote against management or board recommendations in order to oppose management proposals that are not shareholder-friendly in MCM’s view.

6. MCM generally considers each proxy proposal on its merits, and periodically reassesses its views of the management teams of the companies that it invests in for clients. A decision to vote against a particular management or board recommendation or to otherwise abstain or take no action on a proxy proposal does not necessarily signal a departure from MCM’s general view that a management team or board is serving the best interests of shareholders. If MCM concludes, in its sole discretion, that a company’s management team or board no longer appears to be serving shareholders’ best interests, MCM may take any action it deems appropriate, including, without limitation, awaiting further developments, voting against selected management or board recommendations, or selling shares of the company.

 

B-240


Table of Contents

 

Procedures: Use of an Independent Service Provider

7. MCM may engage an independent service provider to assist with the administrative and ministerial aspects of proxy voting. The independent service provider may perform functions that include, without limitation, voting proxies for MCM in accordance with MCM’s instructions based on MCM’s Proxy Voting policy, maintaining records of proxy votes, and assisting in preparing certain reports. To minimize the possibility that MCM’s proxy votes could be affected by potential conflicts of interest that may exist between an independent service provider and a proxy issuer, MCM rarely considers directing such a service provider to vote proxies for MCM based on the service provider’s recommendations (although MCM may do so in certain circumstances discussed in “Alternative Procedures for Potential Material Conflicts of Interest” below).

Procedures: Voting/Abstention/No Action/Other Exceptions

8. MCM seeks to ensure that, to the extent reasonably feasible, proxies for which MCM receives ballots in good order and receives timely notice will be voted or otherwise processed as intended under MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and procedures. MCM employs a number of measures, including certain reconciliations and other cross-check procedures, to attempt to verify that proxies are voted or otherwise processed as intended, although such checks may not be feasible or reliable in some cases because of the complexity of the proxy voting process. MCM’s ability to vote or otherwise process proxies may be limited by many factors, including MCM’s dependence on custodians and independent proxy voting service providers to assist in processing proxies. MCM may be unable to vote or otherwise process proxy ballots that are not received or processed in a timely manner due to functional limitations of the proxy voting system, custodial limitations, or other factors beyond MCM’s control. Such ballots may include, without limitation, ballots for securities out on loan under securities lending programs initiated by a client or its custodian, ballots not timely forwarded by a custodian, or ballots for which MCM does not timely receive essential information such as the proxy proposal itself or modifications to the required voting date. Other ballots may be voted but not counted, or may be counted in an unexpected way, because of factors such as foreign voting requirements or other limitations. For example, in a few foreign markets, ballots cast by MCM may not be counted if required powers of attorney between the client and the custodian are not maintained. Also in foreign markets, ballots for securities held by a custodian in an omnibus account for multiple customers may be voted in an unexpected manner if the custodian receives different voting instructions from its customers and cannot split its vote as each customer requested.

9.a MCM may process some proxies without voting them, such as by making a decision to abstain or take no action on such proxies (or on certain proposals within such proxies). For example, if MCM has decided to sell the shares of a company, MCM generally may abstain from voting proxies or may take no action on proxies issued by the company. If MCM receives proxies relating to securities acquired as a result of an account transition (such as, without limitation, securities delivered into a newly opened MCM account that were selected by a previous adviser), MCM may choose to abstain or take no action on the proxies. MCM also may abstain or take no action on proxies issued for other securities that MCM did not select for a client portfolio (such as, without limitation, unsupervised securities held in a client’s account, or money market securities or other securities selected by clients or their representatives other than MCM).

9.b. MCM may abstain or take no action on proxies (or on certain proposals within such proxies) in other circumstances. MCM may determine, for example, that abstaining or taking no action on proxies is appropriate if voting may be unduly burdensome or expensive, such as when foreign proxy issuers impose burdensome or unreasonable voting, power of attorney, or holding requirements, or if MCM may have a material conflict of interest in voting certain proxies and alternative voting procedures are not desirable. MCM also may abstain or take no action when voting may not be in the best interests of clients in MCM’s view, or as an alternative to voting with (or against) management.

10. The procedures in this policy generally apply to all proxy voting matters over which MCM has voting authority, including changes in corporate governance structures, the adoption or amendment of compensation plans (including stock options), and matters involving social issues or corporate responsibility.

 

B-241


Table of Contents

 

Alternative Procedures for Potential Material Conflicts of Interest

11. In certain circumstances such as when the issuer or other proponent of a proxy proposal is also a client of MCM, it is possible that an appearance might arise of a potential conflict between MCM’s interests and the interests of affected clients in how the proxies of that issuer are voted.

12. MCM seeks to vote or otherwise process proxies in the best interests of its clients, and believes that any potential conflict of interest would not actually affect MCM’s voting of the proxies.

13. Nevertheless, when MCM is aware that a material conflict of interest (as defined in section 3 above) between MCM’s interests and clients’ interests may appear to exist, MCM generally will, to avoid appearance concerns, follow an alternative procedure rather than vote or otherwise process ballots in accordance with its own determinations. Such an alternative procedure generally would involve either:

(i) Directing an independent service provider to cause the proxies of those MCM client accounts that MCM is responsible for processing to be “echo voted” or “mirror voted” in the same proportion as the votes of other proxy holders if the service provider indicates it can do so; or

(ii) Directing the proxies of those MCM client accounts that MCM is responsible for processing to be voted in accordance with the recommendations of an independent service provider that MCM may use to assist in voting proxies. This procedure generally may be used if it can be determined that the independent service provider appears able to make such recommendations and vote in an impartial manner. In making this determination, MCM may (1) require the independent service provider to represent or otherwise demonstrate that the service provider faces no conflict of interest with respect to the vote, or (2) ask the independent service provider to disclose to MCM relevant facts concerning the firm’s relationship with the proxy issuer or other persons and certify that the service provider has taken steps to ensure that no actual conflicts exist.

MCM seeks to document the identification of any material conflict of interest and its procedure for resolving the particular conflict.

14. MCM may use other alternative procedures to address circumstances when a material conflict of interest may appear to exist, such as, without limitation:

(i) Notifying affected clients of the conflict of interest (if it is reasonably feasible to do so), and seeking a waiver of the conflict to permit MCM to vote the proxies;

(ii) Abstaining or taking no action on the proxies in cases when, without limitation, service providers cannot echo vote proxies of certain securities (such as those issued by foreign companies), or in other cases when alternative voting procedures are not desirable; or

(iii) Forwarding the proxies to clients so that clients may vote the proxies themselves.

Voting by Client Instead of MCM

15. An MCM client may elect to vote proxies for its own account instead of directing MCM to do so. MCM recommends this approach if a client believes that proxies should be voted based on political or social interests or other client-specific considerations.

16. MCM generally cannot implement client proxy voting guidelines that do not delegate full discretion to MCM, or that are not fully consistent with these procedures. In particular, MCM encourages the client to vote its own proxies if the client seeks to impose client-specific voting guidelines that may be inconsistent with MCM’s policy or with MCM’s vote-by-vote analysis. MCM does not generally advise a client on proxy voting issues when the client retains authority to handle such matters itself.

 

B-242


Table of Contents

 

17. MCM generally may abstain or will take no action on proxy votes relating to legal proceedings such as shareholder class actions or bankruptcy proceedings, or may refer such votes to clients.

Persons Responsible for Implementing MCM’s Policy

18. MCM’s Operations/Client Services staff has primary responsibility for implementing MCM’s Proxy Voting policy and procedures, including ensuring that proxies are timely submitted. MCM also generally uses a service provider to assist in voting proxies, recordkeeping, and other matters.

19. Members of MCM’s Investment staff, such as security analysts, generally review proxy proposals as part of their ongoing assessment of companies.

Recordkeeping

20.a. MCM or a service provider maintains, in accordance with Rule 204-2 under the Investment Advisers Act:

(i) Copies of all proxy voting policies and procedures;

(ii) Copies of proxy statements received (unless maintained elsewhere as described below);

(iii) Records of proxy votes cast on behalf of clients;

(iv) Documents prepared by MCM that are material to a decision on how to vote or memorializing the basis for a decision;

(v) Written client requests for proxy voting information, and

(vi) Written responses by MCM to written or oral client requests.

20.b. MCM seeks to document instances in which it identifies a material conflict of interest, as well as the procedure utilized for resolving the particular conflict. MCM’s Operations/Client Services Department also documents certain other non-routine proxy voting issues, including: the basis for (1) any decision to vote against a management or board recommendation for reasons other than general matters affecting corporate governance issues discussed in section 5 above; and (2) any decision to abstain or take no action on a proxy that is intended by MCM to demonstrate divergence from a management or board recommendation.

20.c. MCM will not document other, more routine instances in which it may take certain actions with respect to a particular proxy, including certain situations identified in this Proxy Voting policy and procedures. MCM generally will not document, for example, the basis for routine decisions (i) to vote against corporate governance proposals such as those described above, or (ii) to abstain or take no action on proxies in circumstances (A) when foreign issuers impose burdensome or unreasonable voting, power of attorney, or holding requirements, (B) when MCM has sold or determined to sell a security, or when MCM did not select the securities for the client portfolio (such as, without limitation, securities that were selected by a previous adviser, unsupervised securities held in a client’s account, or money market securities or other securities selected by clients or their representatives other than MCM), or (C) when other routine situations arise such as those identified in section 9 above. MCM also cannot document decisions not to vote or otherwise process proxies that were not received in good order, not received in a timely fashion, or otherwise not processed for reasons beyond MCM’s control, such as in certain situations addressed in section 8 above.

21. MCM will obtain an undertaking from any service provider that the service provider will provide copies of proxy voting records and other documents promptly upon request if MCM relies on the service provider to maintain related records.

22. MCM or its service provider may rely on the SEC’s EDGAR system to keep records of certain proxy statements issued by domestic (and some foreign) issuers if the proxy statements are maintained by issuers on that system (as is generally true in the case of larger U.S. – based issuers).

 

B-243


Table of Contents

 

23. All proxy-related records will be maintained in an easily accessible place for five years (and at an appropriate office of MCM or a service provider for the first two years).

Availability of Policy and Proxy Voting Records to Clients

24. MCM will initially inform clients of this policy and provide information regarding how a client may learn of MCM’s voting record for the client’s securities through summary disclosure in Part II of MCM’s Form ADV. Upon receipt of a client’s request for more information, MCM will provide the client with a copy of this Proxy Voting policy. Reports describing how MCM voted proxies for the client during the period since this policy was adopted are also available upon request.

* * *

MCM’s Chief Compliance Officer will review this policy at least annually to determine whether it should be amended or updated. Any amendments to this policy require the written approval of the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

Approved by:    Steven Carlson /s/
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    October 1, 2004
Policy Amended:    February 10, 2006
Approved by:    Steven Carlson /s/
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    February 10, 2006
Policy Amended:    July 19, 2006
Approved by:    Steven Carlson /s/
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    July 19, 2006
Amendment Approved:    August 8, 2008
Approved by:    Steven Carlson
Title:    Chief Compliance Officer
Effective Date:    September 1, 2008

 

B-244


Table of Contents

 

 

 

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

PROXY VOTING POLICY

 

B-245


Table of Contents

 

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

PROXY VOTING POLICY

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

I.   

OBJECTIVE

     B-28   
II.   

ACCOUNTS FOR WHICH BRANDES HAS PROXY VOTING RESPONSIBILITY

     B-28   
III.   

ADHERENCE TO CLIENT PROXY VOTING POLICIES

     B-29   
IV.   

ARRANGEMENTS WITH Proxy Service Providers

     B-29   
V.   

CONFLICTS

     B-30   
VI.   

SPECIAL ISSUES WITH VOTING FOREIGN PROXIES

     B-30   
VII.   

REPORTS

     B-31   
VIII.   

OPERATIONAL PROCEDURES

     B-31   
  

A.

  

Role of the Reorganization Department

     B-31   
  

B.

  

Role of the Investments Group in Voting Proxies

     B-32   
  

C.

  

Role of the Corporate Governance Committee

     B-32   
  

D.

  

Disclosures of Proxy Voting Intentions

     B-32   
IX.   

SECURITIES SUBJECT TO LENDING ARRANGEMENTS

     B-32   
X.   

RECORDKEEPING

     B-32   
XI.   

PROXY VOTING REVIEW COMMITTEE

     B-33   
XII.   

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES SUMMARY

     B-34   
XIII.   

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

     B-34   
  

A.

  

The Board of Directors

     B-34   
  

B.

  

Auditors

     B-36   
  

C.

  

Proxy Contests, Tender Offer Defenses, and Miscellaneous Governance Provisions

     B-36   
   D.   

Capital Structure

     B-39   
   E.   

Executive and Director Compensation

     B-40   
   F.   

Mergers and Corporate Restructurings

     B-42   
   G.   

Reincorporation

     B-42   
   H.   

Money Market Funds

     B-42   
   I.   

Social, Political, and Environmental Issues

     B-43   
XIV.   

PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES FOR BRANDES INVESTMENT TRUST

     B-43   

 

B-246


Table of Contents

 

EFFECTIVE AS OF

MAY 1, 2009

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

PROXY VOTING POLICY

Brandes Investment Partners, L.P. (“Brandes”) generally is responsible for voting proxies with respect to securities held in client accounts, including clients that are pension plans subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (“ERISA Plans”). This document sets forth Brandes’ policy with respect to proxy voting and its procedures to comply with SEC Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940. Specifically, Rule 206(4)-6 requires that we:

 

   

Adopt and implement written policies and procedures reasonably designed to ensure that we vote client securities in the best interest of clients;

 

   

Disclose to clients how they may obtain information from us about how we voted proxies for their securities; and

 

   

Describe our proxy voting policies and procedures to clients and furnish them a copy of our policies and procedures on request.

I. OBJECTIVE

Where Brandes is given responsibility for voting proxies, we must take reasonable steps under the circumstances to ensure that proxies are received and voted in the best interest of our clients, which generally means voting proxies with a view to enhancing the value of the shares of stock held in client accounts.

The financial interest of our clients is the primary consideration in determining how proxies should be voted. In the case of social, political, and environmental responsibility issues that in our view do not primarily involve financial considerations, it is not possible to represent fairly the diverse views of our clients and, thus, unless a client has provided other instructions, Brandes generally votes in accordance with the recommendations of management and/or a third-party proxy service provider (see discussion below) on these issues, although, on occasion Brandes abstains from voting on these issues.

When making proxy-voting decisions, Brandes generally adheres to its Proxy Voting Guidelines (the “Guidelines”), as revised from time to time by Brandes’ Corporate Governance Committee. The Guidelines are described generally in an insert to our Form ADV, Part II and on our website, and are made available to clients on request. The Guidelines, which have been developed with reference to the positions of certain third party proxy service providers, set forth Brandes’ positions on recurring issues and criteria for addressing non-recurring issues.

II. ACCOUNTS FOR WHICH BRANDES HAS PROXY VOTING RESPONSIBILITY

Brandes generally is responsible for voting proxies with respect to securities selected by Brandes and held in client accounts. Brandes’ form Investment Advisory Agreement provides that Brandes is generally responsible for proxy voting unless the client has directed Brandes to the contrary in writing. As a general rule, Brandes does not, however, vote proxies for securities not selected by Brandes but that are nevertheless held in a client account or where Brandes otherwise is not vested with discretionary authority over securities held in a client account.

Although clients may reserve to themselves or assign to another person proxy voting responsibility, certain formalities must be observed in the case of ERISA Plans. Where authority to manage ERISA Plan assets has been delegated to Brandes, this delegation automatically includes responsibility to vote proxies unless the named

 

B-247


Table of Contents

fiduciary that appointed Brandes has expressly reserved to itself or another named fiduciary proxy voting responsibility. To be effective, a reservation of proxy voting responsibility for a given ERISA Plan should:

 

   

Be in writing;

 

   

State that Brandes is “precluded” from voting proxies because proxy voting responsibility is reserved to an identified named fiduciary; and

 

   

Be consistent with the plan’s documents (which should provide for procedures for allocating fiduciary responsibilities among named fiduciaries).

III. ADHERENCE TO CLIENT PROXY VOTING POLICIES

Although clients do not always have proxy voting policies, if a client has such a policy and instructs Brandes to follow it, Brandes will follow those instructions except in any instance in which doing so would be contrary to the economic interests of the plan or otherwise imprudent or unlawful. In the case of ERISA Plans, Brandes, as a fiduciary, is required to discharge its duties in accordance with the documents governing the plan (insofar as they are consistent with ERISA). These documents include statements of proxy voting policy.

Brandes must, to the extent possible, comply with each client’s proxy voting policy (unless in the particular situation voting in such a manner would be imprudent or otherwise inconsistent with applicable law).

IV. ARRANGEMENTS WITH PROXY SERVICE PROVIDERS

Brandes presently uses the following firms as third-party proxy service providers (“PSP”) to assist in voting proxies.

 

   

Risk Metrics Group (“RMG”) is a proxy research, advisory, voting and vote-reporting service that specializes in global proxy voting. RMG’s primary function with respect to Brandes is to appraise it of shareholder meeting dates of all securities holdings, translate proxy materials received from companies, provide associated research and provide considerations and recommendations for voting on particular proxy proposals.

 

   

Broadridge Financial Solutions’ Proxy Edge service is an electronic proxy voting and vote-tracking service. Broadridge’s primary function with respect to Brandes is to apprise it of the shareholder meeting dates of securities holdings, forward copies of proxy materials, and vote proxies in accordance with our instructions.

 

   

Glass, Lewis & Co., LLC is a leading research and professional services firm that assists institutions globally that have investment, financial or reputational exposure to public companies. It provides research and recommendations for Brandes for voting on proxy proposals.

 

   

Proxy Governance, Inc. provides research and proxy voting recommendations on U.S. and non-U.S. publicly traded companies. Coverage is based on securities held in client portfolios. For non-U.S. companies, research and recommendations may be provided through partnerships with other leading proxy advisory firms, or directly by Proxy Governance when proxy materials are reasonably available in a timely manner.

Although we may consider RMG’s and others’ recommendations on proxy issues, Brandes bears ultimate responsibility for proxy voting decisions. For ERISA Plans for which Brandes votes proxies, Brandes is not relieved of its fiduciary responsibility by following directions of a PSP or the ERISA Plans’ named fiduciaries or by delegating proxy voting responsibility to another person.

 

B-248


Table of Contents

 

V. CONFLICTS

Brandes is sensitive to conflicts of interest that may arise in the proxy decision-making process. For example, conflicts of interest may arise when: (i) proxy votes regarding non-routine matters are solicited by an issuer who has an institutional separate account relationship with Brandes; (ii) Brandes has material business relationships with participants in proxy contests, corporate directors or director candidates; or (iii) a Brandes employee has a material personal interest in the outcome of a particular matter before shareholders.

Brandes is committed to resolving all such and similar conflicts in its clients’ best interests. Brandes has developed these policies and procedures to serve the best interests of its clients, and accordingly, will generally vote pursuant to its Guidelines when conflicts of interest arise. When there are proxy voting proposals, however, that give rise to conflicts of interest that are not addressed by the Guidelines, the Corporate Governance Committee will consult the Head of Compliance (“HOC”) and the approach taken to address the conflict situation shall be documented in writing. If necessary, the Corporate Governance Committee, the HOC, and senior management will consult with an independent consultant or outside counsel to resolve material conflicts of interest. Possible resolutions of such conflicts may include: (i) voting in accordance with the guidance of an independent consultant or outside counsel; (ii) erecting information barriers around the person or persons making voting decisions; (iii) designating a person or committee to vote that has no knowledge of any relationship between Brandes and the issuer, its officers or directors, director candidates, or proxy proponents; or (iv) voting in other ways that are consistent with Brandes’ obligation to vote in its clients’ best interests.

Brandes has taken various steps to neutralize potential conflicts that may arise with PSPs, such as RMG, that also provide other products and services to issuers. RMG has made a copy of its policies, procedures and practices regarding potential conflicts of interest available to Brandes. In addition, RMG shall, on a periodic basis, provide Brandes with a list of those companies that have a business relationship with RMG. Brandes exercises best efforts to compare this list to proxies it votes on behalf of clients so that potential conflicts of interest are made known at the time of voting proxies. In addition, Brandes’ Corporate Governance Committee reviews, not less than annually, potential material conflicts of interest disclosed to Brandes by RMG. Finally, Brandes obtains additional proxy voting information from other PSPs as an additional check on the independence of the voting recommendations provided to Brandes by RMG.

VI. SPECIAL ISSUES WITH VOTING FOREIGN PROXIES

Although Brandes has arrangements with PSPs, voting proxies with respect to shares of foreign companies may involve significantly greater effort and corresponding cost due to the variety of regulatory schemes and corporate practices in foreign countries with respect to proxy voting. Logistical problems in voting foreign proxies include the following:

 

   

Each country has its own rules and practices regarding shareholder notification, voting restrictions, registration conditions, and share blocking.

 

   

To vote shares in some countries, the shares may be “blocked” by the custodian or depository (or bearer shares deposited with a specified financial institution) for a specified number of days (usually five or fewer but sometimes longer) before or after the shareholder meeting. When blocked, shares typically may not be traded until the day after the blocking period. Brandes may refrain from voting shares of foreign stocks subject to blocking restrictions where, in Brandes’ judgment, the benefit from voting the shares is outweighed by the interest of maintaining client liquidity in the shares. This decision generally is made on a case-by-case basis based on relevant factors, including the length of the blocking period, the significance of the holding, and whether the stock is considered a long-term holding.

 

   

Often it is difficult to ascertain the date of a shareholder meeting because certain countries do not require companies to publish announcements in any official stock exchange publication.

 

B-249


Table of Contents

 

   

Time frames between shareholder notifications, distribution of proxy materials, book-closure and the actual meeting date may be too short to allow timely action.

 

   

Language barriers will generally mean that an English translation of proxy information must be obtained or commissioned before the relevant shareholder meeting.

 

   

Some companies and/or jurisdictions require that, in order to be eligible to vote, the shares of the beneficial holders be registered in the company’s share registry.

 

   

Lack of a “proxy voting service” by custodians in certain countries. In countries in which custodians do not offer a “proxy voting service”, Brandes will attempt, on a best efforts basis, to lodge votes in such countries.

 

   

Presence of voting fees in countries in which custodians do not offer a “proxy voting service”, may limit Brandes’ ability to lodge votes in such countries.

Because the cost of voting on a particular proxy proposal could exceed the expected benefit to a client (including an ERISA Plan), Brandes may weigh the costs and benefits of voting on proxy proposals relating to foreign securities and make an informed decision on whether voting a given proxy proposal is prudent.

VII. REPORTS

An insert to Brandes’ Form ADV, Part II and the Brandes website describe how clients may obtain information from Brandes about how we voted proxies with respect to their securities. If requested, Brandes provides clients with periodic reports on Brandes’ proxy voting decisions and actions for securities in their accounts, in such forms or intervals as the clients reasonably request. In the case of ERISA Plans, the named fiduciary that appointed Brandes is required to monitor periodically Brandes’ activities, including our decisions and actions with regard to proxy voting. Accordingly, Brandes provides these named fiduciaries on request with reports to enable them to monitor Brandes’ proxy voting decisions and actions, including our adherence (as applicable) to their proxy voting policies.

VIII. OPERATIONAL PROCEDURES

A. Role of the Reorganization Department

Brandes’ Reorganization Department is primarily responsible for receiving, processing and voting proxies for securities held in the portfolios of our clients.

Once a client account is established, the Reorganization Department will monitor for the client’s custodian to forward proxy materials it receives to Brandes and certain PSPs. The Reorganization Department is also responsible for providing the PSPs with a list of client holdings on a regular basis to enable them to track meeting dates and notify Brandes of upcoming meetings.

The Reorganization Department logs the receipt of the materials from various sources in a pending file until the PSPs provide voting recommendations electronically. The Reorganization Department confirms that the correct amount of shares, as of the record date, is generally reflected on the proxy.

It is Brandes’ general policy to have proxies voted at least forty-eight (48) hours prior to the deadline. Unfortunately, in some instances, proxy materials are received with less than a week’s time before the deadline, and in such cases, Brandes uses reasonable efforts to exercise its vote.

The Reorganization Department also compiles and maintains information, for each client for which Brandes votes proxies, showing the issuer’s name, meeting date and manner in which it voted on each proxy proposal. The Reorganization Department is also responsible for developing compliance procedures with respect to client proxy voting policies.

 

B-250


Table of Contents

 

B. Role of the Investments Group in Voting Proxies

Once the PSP’s recommendations and associated research are received electronically, the recommendations and associated materials are transmitted to the relevant investment research team(s) and/or investment committee(s) for consideration. In determining how to vote a given proxy, Brandes generally adheres to the Guidelines, as revised from time to time by the Corporate Governance Committee, except to the extent superseded by client proxy voting policies. Proposals not covered by the Guidelines and contested situations are, at the relevant analyst’s request, evaluated on case-by-case basis by a member of the Corporate Governance Committee and/or the relevant investment research team(s) or investment committee(s). The firm’s voting decisions are then communicated by the Reorganization Department to Broadridge, or other 3rd party voting agents.

C. Role of the Corporate Governance Committee

Brandes’ Corporate Governance Committee is responsible for setting, reviewing from time to time, but at least annually, and making appropriate changes to the firm’s position on various corporate governance issues, as set forth in the Guidelines. The Corporate Governance Committee shall also provide oversight to the firm’s investment research teams and/or investment committees from time to time on significant proxy voting proposals or issues. Generally, a member of the Corporate Governance Committee must approve a decision to vote proxies contrary to the recommendation of the PSPs.

D. Disclosures of Proxy Voting Intentions

Brandes personnel should not discuss with members of the public how Brandes intends to vote on any particular proxy proposal without the advance approval of its General Counsel. This does not restrict communications in the ordinary course of business with named fiduciaries of ERISA Plans or other clients for which Brandes votes proxies. Disclosure of Brandes’ proxy voting intentions – especially where done with the purpose or effect of influencing the management or control of a company – could trigger various restrictions under the federal securities laws, including under the proxy solicitation, beneficial ownership and short-swing profit liability provisions of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

IX. SECURITIES SUBJECT TO LENDING ARRANGEMENTS

For various legal or administrative reasons, Brandes is often unable to vote securities that are, at the time of such vote, on loan pursuant to a client’s securities lending arrangement with the client’s custodian. Brandes will refrain from voting such securities where the costs to the client and/or administrative inconvenience of retrieving securities then on loan are perceived to outweigh the benefit of voting, assuming retrieval under such circumstances is even feasible and/or possible. In certain extraordinary situations, Brandes may seek to have securities then on loan pursuant to such securities lending arrangements retrieved by the clients’ custodians for voting purposes. This decision will generally be made on a case-by-case basis depending on whether, in Brandes’ judgment, the matter to be voted on has critical significance to the potential value of the securities in question, the relative cost and/or administrative inconvenience of retrieving the securities, the significance of the holding, and whether the stock is considered a long-term holding. There can be no guarantee that any such securities can be retrieved for such purpose.

X. RECORDKEEPING

The Brandes Reorganization Department will maintain copies of the following records for a period of five years, the first two in an easily accessible place, in accordance with the Investment Advisers Act of 1940. Specifically, Rule 204-2 requires that we:

 

   

Copies of all policies and procedures relating to proxy voting.

 

   

A copy of each proxy statement received regarding client securities.

 

B-251


Table of Contents

 

   

A record of each vote cast on behalf of a client.

 

   

A copy of any document created by Brandes that was material to making a decision how to vote proxies on behalf of the client or that memorializes the basis for that decision.

 

   

A copy of each written client request for information on how Brandes voted proxies on behalf of the client, and a copy of any written response by Brandes to any (written and oral) client request for information on how Brandes voted proxies on behalf of the requesting client.

XI. PROXY VOTING REVIEW COMMITTEE

No less frequently than annually, the Proxy Voting Review Committee shall meet to review and discuss the operation of Brandes’ proxy voting procedures. The Committee shall consist of, at least, the following individuals:

 

   

The HOC (who shall act of the Chair of the committee)

 

   

The General Counsel or his/her designee

 

   

A representative of the Corporate Governance Committee

 

   

A representative of the Reorganization Department

 

   

A representative of the Research Department

In reviewing the proxy voting procedures, the Committee shall consider the operation of the policies and procedures since the previous review, including but not limited to the following areas:

 

   

Operational aspects of the policies and procedures (e.g., is information getting to the necessary people in a timely fashion or have any votes been missed)

 

   

Maintenance of all required records

 

   

Performance of service providers (RMG, Broadridge, Glass Lewis and Proxy Governance)

 

   

Conflict of interest issues

 

   

Any instances where Brandes has failed to comply with its policies

 

   

Any suggested revisions to the policies and procedures

The HOC shall meet with the Office of the CEO no less frequently than annually to discuss the results of the Proxy Voting Committee’s review of the policies and procedures.

 

B-252


Table of Contents

 

BRANDES INVESTMENT PARTNERS, L.P.

XII. PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES SUMMARY

Summary

With the understanding that many of the issues below are dealt with in detail in these Proxy Voting Guidelines (the “Guidelines”), Brandes’ current policies with respect to a number of more common issues are briefly summarized as follows:

 

   

Brandes typically votes with the recommendations of a company’s Board of Directors on routine or non-controversial issues.

 

   

In general, Brandes opposes anti-takeover proposals and supports the elimination of anti-takeover policies, unless unusual circumstances dictate otherwise.

 

   

In general, Brandes supports proposals that enhance shareholder rights through protecting the ability to call special meetings, act by written consent, access proxy voting materials, and by lowering the requirement for supermajority shareholder vote requirements on certain important governance issues.

 

   

It is not possible to represent fairly the diverse views of our clients on proposals regarding social, political, and environmental issues and, therefore, unless directed by a client to vote in a certain manner, we will generally vote in accordance with the recommendations of management and/or RMG or abstain from voting on the respective issues.

 

   

Proposals not covered by the Guidelines and contested situations will be evaluated on a case-by-case basis by a member of the relevant investment research team(s) or investment committee(s) and/or the Corporate Governance Committee, typically with reference to third-party recommendations and analysis.

XIII. PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

The following guidelines have been developed with reference to the positions of Risk Metrics Group (“RMG”), formerly Institutional Shareholders Services, Inc, (“ISS”). Exceptions and modifications to these guidelines may occur with respect to issues that arise relating to certain companies and/or unique circumstances in certain countries.

A. The Board of Directors

1. Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections

We generally support the election of a company’s nominees for director and believe that the board’s nominating committee is in the best possible position to evaluate the qualification of directors and the needs of a particular board. Brandes believes that the election of a majority of independent directors is critical to long term shareholder value. In determining whether to support a board nominee, we will consider the following factors:

 

   

Long-term corporate performance record relative to a market index;

 

   

Composition of board and key board committees;

 

   

Nominee’s attendance at meetings (past two years);

 

   

Nominee’s investment in the company;

 

   

Whether a retired CEO sits on the board; and

 

   

Whether the chairman is also serving as CEO.

 

B-253


Table of Contents

 

In cases of significant votes and when information is readily available, we also review:

 

   

Corporate governance provisions and takeover activity;

 

   

Board decisions regarding executive pay;

 

   

Director compensation;

 

   

Number of other board seats held by nominee; and

 

   

Interlocking directorships.

2. Voting on Director Nominees in Contested Elections

We review on a case-by-case basis the directors nominated for election in contested elections, considering the following factors:

 

   

Long-term financial performance of the target company relative to its industry;

 

   

Management’s track record;

 

   

Background to the proxy contest;

 

   

Qualifications of director nominees (both slates);

 

   

Strategic plan of dissident nominated directors and quality of critique against management;

 

   

Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates);

 

   

Stock ownership positions.

3. Voting on Director Nominees by Bundled Slate

In countries where directors are voted on by slate, we will generally abstain from voting on the board of directors when presented as a slate and there is no disclosure on the individual directors.

Disclosure of director background, experience, performance and accountability to shareholder interests is favored in order that shareholders may vote appropriately for the most qualified director nominees who would add value to the management of the company.

4. Separating Chairman/CEO

We will generally vote for resolutions to separate the Chairman and CEO positions unless the company has a strong countervailing governance structure, which includes an independent lead director that is elected by and from the independent board members with clearly delineated duties, a minimum two-thirds independent board, all key committees comprised of independent directors, and established governance guidelines.

5. Majority of Independent Directors

We vote for shareholder proposals that request that the board be comprised of a majority of independent directors. In determining the independence of a board member, we base the classification on the standards issued by the primary stock exchange in which the company is listed.

We generally vote for shareholder proposals that request that the board audit, compensation and/or nominating committees include independent directors exclusively.

 

B-254


Table of Contents

 

6. Stock Ownership Requirements

We generally vote against shareholder proposals requiring directors to own a minimum amount of company stock in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board.

7. Term of Office

We generally vote against shareholder proposals to limit the tenure of outside directors.

8. Director and Officer Indemnification and Liability Protection

Proposals concerning director and officer indemnification and liability protection are evaluated on a case-by-case basis.

We generally vote against proposals to limit or eliminate entirely director and officer liability for monetary damages for violating the duty of care.

We generally vote against indemnification proposals that would expand coverage beyond just legal expenses to acts, such as negligence, that are more serious violations of fiduciary obligations than mere carelessness.

We generally vote for only those proposals that provide such expanded coverage in cases when a director’s or officer’s legal defense was unsuccessful if: (1) the director was found to have acted in good faith and in a manner that he reasonably believed was in the best interests of the company, and (2) only if the director’s legal expenses would be covered.

B. Auditors

We generally rely on the judgment of the board’s audit committee in selecting the independent auditors that will provide the best service to the company. In doing so, we generally support the ratification or reappointment of the company’s auditor unless:

 

   

The auditor has a significant professional or personal relationship with the issuer that compromises the firm’s independence;

 

   

There is reason to believe the auditor has rendered an opinion that is neither accurate nor indicative of the company’s financial position; or

 

   

The auditors receive a significant amount of compensation for non-auditing activities or consulting activities.

C. Proxy Contests, Tender Offer Defenses, and Miscellaneous Governance Provisions

1. Board Structure: Staggered vs. Annual Elections

We vote against proposals to classify the board.

We vote for proposals to repeal classified boards and to elect all directors annually.

2. Shareholder Ability to Remove Directors

We vote against proposals that provide that directors may be removed only for cause.

We vote for proposals to restore shareholder ability to remove directors with or without cause.

 

B-255


Table of Contents

 

We vote for proposals that require director nominees to be elected by the affirmative vote of the majority of votes cast at an annual meeting of shareholders, provided such proposals include adequate provisions which address vote standards in contested elections of directors.

We vote against proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

We vote for proposals that permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

3. Cumulative Voting

We will generally vote against proposals to eliminate cumulative voting and will generally vote for proposals to provide for or restore cumulative voting unless the company currently provides for Proxy Access or a similar structure or has adopted a Majority Vote Standard.

In situations where insider voting power is greater than 50%, i.e. controlled company, we will generally vote for proposals to provide for cumulative voting.

4. Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings

We vote against proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to call special meetings.

We vote for proposals that remove restrictions on the right of shareholders to act independently of management.

5. Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent

We vote against proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholder ability to take action by written consent.

We vote for proposals to allow or make easier shareholder action by written consent.

6. Poison Pills

We vote for shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification.

We generally vote for shareholder proposals to redeem a company’s poison pill.

We generally vote against management proposals to ratify a poison pill.

We generally advocate withholding votes from board members who adopt or renew dead-hand poison pills or their variants.

7. Greenmail

We vote for proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

We review on case-by-case basis anti-greenmail proposals, when they are bundled with other charter or bylaw amendments.

 

B-256


Table of Contents

 

8. Unequal Voting Rights

We vote against dual class exchange offers.

We vote against dual class recapitalizations.

9. Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Amend the Charter or Bylaws

We vote against management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve charter and bylaw amendments.

We vote for shareholder proposals to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements for charter and bylaw amendments.

10. Supermajority Shareholder Vote Requirement to Approve Mergers

We vote against management proposals to require a supermajority shareholder vote to approve mergers and other significant business combinations.

We vote for shareholder proposals to lower supermajority shareholder vote requirements for mergers and other significant business combinations.

11. Confidential Voting

We generally vote for shareholder proposals that request corporations adopt confidential voting, use independent tabulators and use independent inspectors of elections. We vote for management proposals to adopt confidential voting.

12. Equal Access

We vote for shareholder proposals that would allow significant company shareholders equal access to management’s proxy material in order to evaluate and propose voting recommendations on proxy proposals and director nominees, and in order to nominate their own candidates to the board.

13. Bundled Proposals

We review on a case-by-case basis, bundled or “conditioned” proxy proposals. In the case of items that are conditioned upon each other, we examine the benefits and costs of the packaged items. In instances when the joint effect of the conditioned items is not in shareholders’ best interests, we vote against the proposals. If the combined effect is positive, we support such proposals.

14. Majority-Supported Shareholder Proposals

We will consider a recommendation on withholding votes from board members who fail to take action on shareholder proposals supported by a majority of votes cast for two consecutive years or a majority of shares outstanding for one year on a case-by-case basis. A vote to withhold votes will be based, in part, on the following principles:

 

   

Our “withhold” policy applies to incumbent board members and excludes new nominees to the board (i.e., those being nominated for the first time).

 

   

A board ignoring two different majority-supported proposals in back-to-back years will face a “withhold” recommendation.

 

B-257


Table of Contents

 

   

If after two or more years of majority votes the proposal is not resubmitted, our decision to continue withholding votes in subsequent years will be case-by-case, based on whether or not shareholders are still engaging the company on the issue in some manner, such as a “vote no” campaign.

15. Miscellaneous Governance Provisions

All other governance related issues not specifically addressed elsewhere in these Guidelines are voted on a case-by-case basis upon evaluating each proposal on its merits, based on the particular facts and circumstances.

D. Capital Structure

1. Common Stock Authorization

We review on case-by-case basis proposals to increase the number of shares of common stock authorized for issue.

We vote against proposed common stock authorizations that increase the existing issued share capital by more than 100% unless a clear need for the excess shares is presented by the company.

We vote against proposed common stock authorizations without preemptive rights that are in excess of 5% of the company’s issued share capital.

2. Stock Distributions: Splits and Dividends

We vote for management proposals to increase common share authorization for a stock split, provided that the split does not result in an increase of authorized but unissued shares of more than 100% after giving effect to the shares needed for the split.

3. Blank Check Preferred Authorization

We vote for proposals to create blank check preferred stock in cases when the company expressly states that the stock will not be used as a takeover defense or carry superior voting rights.

We review on a case-by-case basis proposals that would authorize the creation of new classes of preferred stock with unspecified voting, conversion, dividend and distribution, and other rights.

We review on a case-by-case basis proposals to increase the number of authorized blank check preferred shares.

4. Shareholder Proposals Regarding Blank Check Preferred Stock

We vote for shareholder proposals to have blank check preferred stock placements, other than those shares issued for the purpose of raising capital or making acquisitions in the normal course of business, submitted for shareholder ratification.

5. Adjust Par Value of Common Stock

We vote for management proposals to reduce the par value of common stock.

6. Preemptive Rights

We review on case-by-case basis proposals to create or abolish preemptive rights. In evaluating proposals on preemptive rights, we look at the size of a company and the characteristics of its shareholder base.

 

B-258


Table of Contents

 

7. Debt Restructurings

We review on a case-by-case basis proposals to increase common and/or preferred shares and to issue shares as part of a debt-restructuring plan. We consider the following issues:

 

   

Dilution — How much will ownership interest of existing shareholders be reduced, and how extreme will dilution to any future earnings be?

 

   

Change in Control — Will the transaction result in a change in control of the company?

 

   

Bankruptcy — Is the threat of bankruptcy, which would result in severe losses in shareholder value, the main factor driving the debt restructuring?

Generally, we vote for proposals that facilitate debt restructurings unless there are clear signs of self-dealing or other abuses.

8. Share Repurchase Programs

We vote for management proposals to institute open-market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

E. Executive and Director Compensation

In general, we vote on a case-by-case basis on executive and director compensation plans with the view that viable compensation programs reward the creation of shareholder wealth by having high payout sensitivity to increases in shareholder value.

In evaluating a compensation plan, we consider equity-based compensation along with the cash components of pay and attempt to determine the dilutive effect both on shareholder wealth and on voting power. However, in recognition of the fact that it is difficult, if not impossible, for us to develop specific quantitative rules regarding compensation plans that apply to all companies, we instead tend to focus on the following:

 

   

The process used by a company to establish compensation plans. Is it fundamentally sound (i.e., is the process logical; are outside experts employed) and replete with independence?

 

   

The structure of the overall compensation program. Does the total potential compensation (cash and non-cash elements) appear reasonable and fair for this company and industry?

 

   

The link between compensation and the creation of long-term shareholder value. Does the plan:

 

   

Incentivize long-term thinking and stewardship of the company instead of focusing on achieving short-term metrics?

 

   

Provide for adequate compensation to attract and retain competent managerial talent suitable to the challenges and opportunities faced by the individual company?

 

   

Directly tie incentive compensation to performance with above-average rewards only being earned if shareholders are being rewarded with above-average corporate performance?

 

   

Include downside potential as well as up-side rewards without the possibility for a material “second chance” (i.e. repricing of options)?

 

   

Measure performance on clearly objective criteria that are consistent with increases in shareholder value (i.e., ROIC, EVA, etc.)?

 

   

Require significant ongoing share ownership by the executive or director?

 

B-259


Table of Contents

 

Other factors we consider in evaluating compensation plans include the following:

1. Disclosure Policy for Compensation Plans

When reviewing compensation plans in markets where information is limited, at the very minimum, we seek to obtain information regarding (1) the total dilution level and (2) the exercise price.

In markets where certain terms are regularly disclosed and a company has not disclosed this information, we generally a vote against the plan for substandard disclosure.

2. Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation – Say-on-Pay

We will generally vote for shareholder sponsored Say-on-Pay proposals, calling for advisory votes on executive compensation, unless the company currently provides for Proxy Access or a similar structure and/or has adopted a Majority Vote Standard.

In cases where a company has adopted an Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation, we will generally vote on a case-by-case basis, considering the above mentioned factors.

3. Discounted Options and Restricted Stock

We oppose discounted options and restricted stock without performance criteria, with the exception of restricted stock in U.S.-style stock option plans, which will be reviewed on a case-by-case basis.

We consider supporting option plans that allow for discounted options if exercise is contingent on the achievement of well defined and challenging performance criteria.

4. Options Expensing

We will generally vote for shareholder proposals to expense options. We will not support such a shareholder resolution if the company has already publicly committed to expensing options by a specific date.

5. Option Repricing

We generally oppose the repricing of options, which includes all of the following that constitute repricings

 

   

Reduction in exercise price of outstanding options.

 

   

Cancellation and regrant of options at lower exercise prices. This will include 6&1 (six-month and one-day) cancellations/regrants and bullet options (a type of 6&1 with accelerated vesting).

 

   

Substitution of restricted stock for underwater options.

 

   

Buyback of underwater options and issuance of new awards.

6. Performance-Based Stock Options

We will examine shareholder proposals advocating the use of performance-based stock options on a case-by-case basis. Voting decision will therefore take into account the following:

 

   

Whether the proposal mandates that all awards be performance-based.

 

   

Whether the proposal extends beyond executive awards to those of lower ranking employees.

 

   

Whether the company’s stock-based compensation plans meet certain shareholder value transfer criteria and do not violate our repricing guidelines.

 

B-260


Table of Contents

 

7. Plan Amendments

We generally vote for amendments that improve the overall structure of given compensation plan, even if the underlying plan does not necessarily meet our guidelines.

F. Mergers and Corporate Restructurings

1. Mergers and Acquisitions

Votes on mergers and acquisitions are considered on a case-by-case basis, taking into account at least the following:

 

   

Anticipated financial and operating benefits;

 

   

Offer price (cost vs. premium);

 

   

Prospects of the combined companies;

 

   

How the deal was negotiated; and

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights.

2. Corporate Restructuring

Votes on corporate restructuring proposals, including minority squeeze outs, leveraged buyouts, spin-offs, liquidations, and asset sales are considered on a case-by-case basis.

3. Spin-offs

Votes on spin-offs are considered on a case-by-case basis depending on the tax and regulatory advantages, planned use of sale proceeds, market focus, and managerial incentives.

4. Asset Sales

Votes on asset sales are made on a case-by-case basis after considering the impact on the balance sheet/working capital, value received for the asset, and potential elimination of diseconomies.

5. Liquidations

Votes on liquidations are made on a case-by-case basis after reviewing management’s efforts to pursue other alternatives, appraisal value of assets, and the compensation plan for executives managing the liquidation.

6. Appraisal Rights

We vote for proposals to restore, or provide shareholders with, rights of appraisal.

G. Reincorporation

Proposals to change a company’s state or country of incorporation are reviewed on a case-by-case basis, giving consideration to both financial and corporate governance factors including the reason for reincorporation, a comparison of the governance provisions and jurisdictional laws, and potential economic costs and benefits.

H. Money Market Funds

For money market funds in which we have not selected the fund, we will not review proxies, but instead we will vote with the recommendations of a third party proxy service provider on all proposals. In rare circumstances when no such entity provides recommendations, we vote proposals in accordance with the recommendations of management.

 

B-261


Table of Contents

 

I. Social, Political, and Environmental Issues

In the case of social, political, and environmental responsibility issues that in our view do not primarily involve financial considerations, it is not possible to represent fairly the diverse views of our clients and, thus, unless a client has provided other instructions, we generally vote in accordance with the recommendations of RMG on these issues, although, on occasion we abstain from voting on these issues.

XIV. PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES FOR BRANDES INVESTMENT TRUST

The Board of Trustees of Brandes Investment Trust (the “Company”) has adopted the following policy and procedures with respect to voting proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Company’s investment portfolio (“Fund”).

A. Proxy Voting Policy

The policy of the Company is to delegate the responsibility for voting proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Fund to Brandes Investment Partners (the “Adviser”) as a part of the Adviser’s general management of the Fund, subject to the Board’s continuing oversight.

B. Fiduciary Duty

The right to vote proxies with respect to portfolio securities held by the Fund is an asset of the Company. The Adviser acts as a fiduciary of the Fund and must vote proxies in a manner consistent with the best interest of the Fund and its shareholders.

C. Proxy Voting Procedures

 

  1. At least annually, the Adviser shall present to the Board its policies, procedures and other guidelines for voting proxies. In addition, the Adviser shall notify the Board promptly of materials changes to any of these documents.

 

  2. At least annually, the Adviser shall provide to the Board a record of each proxy voted with respect to portfolio securities of the Fund during the year. With respect to those proxies that the Adviser has identified as involving a conflict of interest, the Adviser shall submit a separate report indicating the nature of the conflict of interest and how that conflict was resolved with respect to the voting of the proxy. For this purpose, a “conflict of interest” shall be deemed to occur when the Adviser or an affiliated person of the Adviser has a financial interest in a matter presented by a proxy to be voted on behalf of the Fund, which may compromise the Adviser’s independence of judgment and action in voting the proxy.

D. Revocation of Authority to Vote

The delegation by the Board of the authority to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities of the Fund may be revoked by the board, in whole or in part, at any time.

E. Annual Filing of Proxy Voting Record

 

  1. The Company shall include in its Form N-1A registration statement:

 

  a. A description of this policy and of the policies and procedures used by the Adviser to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities; and

 

B-262


Table of Contents

 

  b. A statement disclosing that information regarding how the Company voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30 is available without charge, upon request, by calling the Company’s toll-free telephone number (or through a specified Internet address or both) and on the SEC website.

 

  2. The Company shall include in it Annual and Semi-Annual Report to shareholders:

 

  a. A statement that a description of the policies and procedures used by or on behalf of the Company to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities of the Fund is available without charge, upon request, by calling the Company’s toll-free telephone number or through a specified Internet address, and on the SEC website.

 

  b. A statement that information regarding how the Company voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30 is available without charge, upon request, by calling the Company’s toll-free number (or through a specified Internet address or both) and on the SEC website.

 

B-263


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C — SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R shares and Class R4 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R shares and Class R4 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1?2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

  * Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

  ** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

 

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

C-3


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX D — DESCRIPTION OF STATE CONDITIONS

STATE SPECIFIC INFORMATION

Each Fund’s investments are highly dependent on and sensitive to the general fiscal and economic stability of the state in which the Fund invests, as well as the general fiscal and economic stability of the state’s subdivisions, agencies, instrumentalities or authorities, which issue the securities in which the Fund invests. The following information supplements information set forth in each Fund’s prospectuses, constitutes only a brief summary and does not purport to be a complete description of certain state-specific considerations and is provided to investors in view of each Fund’s policy of concentrating its investments in securities issued by issuers of a single state. The information is based on publicly available sources and has not been independently verified by the Adviser but is believed to be accurate in all material respects. It is expected that the information will be updated only on an annual basis and thus may be out of date at any time that you make an investment decision to purchase or sell shares of a Fund.

To the extent that any statements made below involve matters of forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates, whether or not expressly stated to be such, they are made as such and not as representations of fact or certainty, and no representation is made that any of these statements has been or will be realized. All forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates are “forward looking statements” that must be read with an abundance of caution and that may not be realized or may not occur in the future.

California

The following information relates specifically to the California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund (the Fund). This summary does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all relevant facts. Although the Fund has no reason to believe that the information summarized below is not correct in all material respects, such information has not been independently verified for accuracy or thoroughness. Rather, this information has been obtained from official statements, prospectuses and other disclosure provided in connection with various securities offerings of the State of California (California or the State) and local agencies in California available as of the date of this Statement of Additional Information. Further, all estimates and projections contained in the following information should not be construed as statements of fact. They are based on assumptions that may be affected by numerous factors and there can be no assurance that such estimates and projections will be realized or achieved.

General Economic Factors.

California’s economy, the largest among the 50 states and one of the largest and most diverse in the world, has major components in high technology, trade, entertainment, agriculture, manufacturing, government, tourism, construction and services. The relative proportion of the various components of the California economy closely resembles the make-up of the national economy.

In the May Revision of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget (as defined below), released May 14, 2010 (the “2010-11 May Revision”), the California Department of Finance (the “Department of Finance”) reported that the California economy started to recover from the recession in the latter part of 2009, but projected that growth in calendar year 2010 and beyond would be slow and would continue to lag slightly behind the national economic recovery as a whole. As of May 2010, unemployment in the State was 12.4%, compared to 12.5% in January 2010 and 9.7% in January 2009. The United States unemployment rate for May 2010 was 9.7%.

Current Financial Stress.

The State experienced a severe economic recession that began in the first quarter of 2008 and ended at some point in the second half of 2009. Personal income fell in the first three quarters of 2009 before increasing moderately in the fourth quarter of 2009. Taxable sales fell sharply in the first half of 2009 before increasing

 

D-1


Table of Contents

substantially in the fourth quarter of 2009 and the first quarter of 2010. The State’s unemployment rate increased from 5.9% in January 2008 to 12.4% in May 2010. The rate of increase has slowed in 2010. There can be no assurances that the fiscal stress and cash pressures currently facing the State will not continue or become more difficult, or that continuing declines in State tax receipts or other impacts of the current economic situation will not further materially adversely affect the financial condition of the State.

In response to the most severe economic downturn in the United States since the Great Depression, in the State’s budget plan for fiscal year 2009-10 adopted on February 20, 2009, as amended by the revisions enacted on July 28, 2009, together with other related budget legislation (the “Amended 2009 Budget Act”), the State implemented substantial spending reductions, program eliminations, revenue increases, and other solutions in order to close an estimated $60 billion budget gap over the combined 2008-09 and 2009-10 fiscal years. The State adopted reforms in nearly every area of government to better contain costs in the future. The 2010-11 May Revision included further reductions to many programs. If these proposals are adopted, it would bring overall General Fund spending to a level well below what it was a decade ago in fiscal year 1998-99 adjusted for population and inflation growth.

The State is slowly emerging from the recession, but economic growth is modest and the level of unemployment is still very high. Consequently, baseline General Fund revenues in fiscal year 2009-10 (consisting of total revenues adjusted to remove temporary tax law changes and one-time receipts) are projected to fall by more than 20% from their peak in fiscal year 2007-08. Major components of the revenue decline are capital gains taxes ($8 billion below peak levels), income tax on wages (approximately $6 billion below peak levels), tax on other types of income ($7 billion below peak levels), sales taxes ($10 billion below peak levels), corporate taxes ($2 billion below peak levels), and all other taxes (approximately $1 billion below peak levels). Consumer spending driven by easy credit and growth in home values is also not likely to return to prior levels in the foreseeable future. Future revenues will also be affected by the expiration of temporary tax increases enacted in fiscal year 2009-10.

In January 2010, California’s projected budget gap for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 was $19.9 billion. The deterioration of the State’s fiscal condition since adoption of the Amended 2009 Budget Act was due to a combination of lower than projected revenues, failure to achieve expected savings (due in part to adverse court decisions), and population and caseload growth. A special session of the California Legislature in February 2010 enacted several bills that addressed approximately $2.1 billion of this gap. Further reduced revenue estimates ($0.6 billion) and higher expenditure estimates ($0.7 billion) added approximately $1.3 billion to the gap, so that the 2010-11 May Revision projected the remaining budget gap at $19.1 billion. This figure is comprised of a fiscal year 2009-10 shortfall of $7.7 billion, a fiscal year 2010-11 shortfall of $10.2 billion, and a $1.2 billion reserve for fiscal year 2010-11.

The 2010-11 May Revision proposed additional solutions to close the remaining budget gap. Additional federal funds (over and above the $2.2 billion already approved) account for $3.4 billion in solutions, a reduction from the $6.9 billion of additional federal funds contained in Governor’s Proposed Budget for the 2010-11 fiscal year released on January 8, 2010 (the “2010-11 Governor’s Budget”). Spending reductions account for $12.4 billion in solutions. Additional solutions include $1.3 billion in alternative funding and $2.1 billion in fund shifts and other revenues. In response, California Legislative leaders have proposed two different budget plans, one of which calls for significant tax increases, and another that would rely on a borrowing plan using certain significant non-General Fund revenues. All such proposals are now being considered by the California Legislature. Even if all the Governor’s proposals were to be adopted, the Administration still projects that there will be multi-billion dollar budget gaps in future years, as temporary fiscal measures adopted in recent years have to be repaid or temporary tax increases expire.

The sharp drop in revenues over the last two fiscal years also resulted in a significant depletion of cash resources to pay the State’s obligations. For a period of one month, in February 2009, the State deferred making certain payments from the General Fund in order to conserve cash resources for high priority obligations, such as

 

D-2


Table of Contents

education and debt service. By July 2009, as new budget gaps were identified and with the failure to adopt corrective actions, the State’s cash resources had dwindled so far that, commencing July 2, 2009, the State Controller began to issue registered warrants (or “IOUs”) for certain lower priority obligations in lieu of warrants (checks), which registered warrants could not be immediately cashed. The registered warrants, the issuance of which did not require the consent of the recipients thereof, bore interest. The registered warrants were all called for redemption on September 4, 2009, once the State was able to access the public credit markets for cash management purposes following enactment of the Amended 2009 Budget Act. No registered warrants were used to make high-priority payments, including debt service on bonds, payments to schools, or employee payrolls. The issuance of State registered warrants in 2009 was only the second time the State has issued State registered warrants since the 1930s.

The 2010-11 May Revision projected that the State would have sufficient cash resources to pay all of its obligations through the end of fiscal year 2009-10, including repayment of all outstanding revenue anticipation notes in June 2010 (a first maturity of $2.825 billion was paid on May 25, 2010). Legislation enacted during the fiscal emergency special session of the California Legislature in early March 2010 will provide the State with additional tools to manage cash in the summer of 2010 and during key months of the budget year by authorizing short-term deferral of certain State payments, primarily to schools and local governments. Proposals to close the budget shortfall will substantially reduce this cash gap. In addition to budget solutions, the State will need to obtain external financing early in fiscal year 2010-11. At the Governor’s direction, the Department of Finance has begun working with the State Controller’s Office and the State Treasurer’s Office to develop additional cash solutions as needed to meet the State’s payment obligations.

The national and California economies improved between the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget and the 2010-11 May Revision. Output of the national economy grew for the third consecutive quarter in the first quarter of 2010, and California payroll employment grew in four of the six consecutive months ending in March 2010. However, some sectors of both economies have yet to show any positive signs – construction being a prime example.

There are signs that home prices have begun to stabilize and have improved in many regions of the State. Existing home sales peaked during the summer of 2005 and fell steadily through November 2008. A robust recovery in sales took place between November 2008 and November 2009, as sales were boosted by the first-time homebuyers’ tax credit. The tax credit was initially set to expire at the end of November 2009, but, prior to its expiration, it was extended through April 30, 2010. Following the tax credit’s extension, there was a moderate rebound in sales in March 2010. The tax credit’s expiration on April 30, 2010, coupled with severe winter weather, caused home sales to fall again.

The longest and deepest recession in the post-Depression era is most likely over. Both the State and national economies appear poised to make modest comebacks, and many indicators released since the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget forecast have been more encouraging than originally expected. Still, the recovery will probably be moderate and prolonged by historical standards.

The pension funds managed by the State’s principal retirement systems, the California Public Employees’ Retirement System and the California State Teachers’ Retirement System, have sustained significant investment losses during the economic downturn and currently have substantial unfunded liabilities that will require increased contributions from the General Fund in future years. The State also has an unfunded liability relating to retirees’ post-employment healthcare benefits that was estimated to be $51.8 billion as of June 30, 2009.

Recent Developments.

On May 14, 2010, the Governor released the 2010-11 May Revision. The 2010-11 May Revision disclosed that General Fund revenues in April 2010 were approximately $3.6 billion lower than projected in the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget, reversing three consecutive months of revenue results that exceeded forecasts. The majority

 

D-3


Table of Contents

of the shortfall was in personal income tax receipts and occurred for several reasons. First, extraordinary amounts of 2008 capital losses were carried forward into the 2009 tax year. Second, small business owners had less income in 2009 than had been projected at the time of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget. Lastly, in response to tax law changes, it appears that many quarterly filers paid a greater percentage of their estimated payments prior to April 2010 than was predicted at the time of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget, thus reducing final payments in April 2010.

On May 4, 2010, a California Superior Court judge ruled in favor of the State in the case of California Redevelopment Association et al. v. Genest et al. This ruling upheld a provision in the Amended 2009 Budget Act that required redevelopment agencies around the State to transfer $1.7 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $350 million in fiscal year 2010-11 to support public school funding within their jurisdictions (thereby relieving the General Fund from an equal amount of payments under Proposition 98). The decision has been appealed by the redevelopment agencies; however, substantially all of the transfers have been made.

On May 19, 2010, a lawsuit was filed on behalf of individual students, school districts, and educational organizations against the State (Robles-Wong et al. v. State of California) alleging that the State’s system of financing public schools is inconsistent with the mandate of the State Constitution to support public education. The suit seeks a declaration that the current system of school financing is unconstitutional and orders for the California Legislature and Governor to devise an adequate system of school financing.

On June 9, 2010, the California Supreme Court granted review of the Court of Appeal decision upholding the Governor’s vetoes of spending in the Amended 2009 Budget Act. There is no time yet set for hearing or decision in this case but the California Supreme Court set an accelerated briefing schedule with all briefings due by July 14, 2010.

On June 14, 2010, the United States Supreme Court granted the State’s petition for review of the decision by a three-judge federal court which ordered a reduction of the State prison population. It is expected that the case will be heard and decided during the United States Supreme Court’s 2010-11 term.

A number of initiative petitions have been filed with the California Secretary of State and will be placed on the November 2, 2010, election ballot. A number of the proposals would, if ultimately approved by the voters, impact State finances in various ways, as briefly summarized below.

 

   

Legalize sale of marijuana, which could produce increased State revenues if taxes are levied on such sales.

 

   

Raise the vehicle license fee by $18 annually and dedicate these funds to support State parks, reducing General Fund expenditures.

 

   

Restrict the ability of the State to use or borrow money from local governments and moneys dedicated to transportation financing.

 

   

Reduce the required vote in each house of the California Legislature to adopt the annual budget to a majority from two-thirds.

 

   

Repeal certain corporate tax breaks enacted as part of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, increasing future General Fund revenues.

On June 16, 2010, the California Public Employees’ Retirement System (“CaIPERS”) adopted a proposal that will increase the amount the State must contribute to CaIPERS for State employee pensions in fiscal year 2010-11. The State projects this will result in an increase in contributions of approximately $281 million, approximately 55% of which must be paid from the General Fund.

Subsequent to the 2010-11 May Revision, the Administration entered into tentative contract agreements with representatives of several bargaining units, representing more than 22,000 employees. These tentative

 

D-4


Table of Contents

agreements still require ratification by union members and the California Legislature. It is estimated that these contracts would save the State $72 million ($43 million General Fund savings) in fiscal year 2010-11.

Bond Ratings.

Three major credit rating agencies, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”), Standard and Poor’s Ratings Services (“S&P”), and Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”), assign ratings to California long-term general obligation bonds. The ratings of Moody’s, S&P, and Fitch represent their respective opinions as to the quality of the municipal bonds they rate. It should be emphasized, however, that ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality. Consequently, municipal bonds with the same maturity, coupon, and rating may have different yields while obligations with the same maturity and coupon with different ratings may have the same yield.

In April 2010, Fitch raised its rating assigned to California’s general obligation bonds from BBB to A-minus, and Moody’s raised its rating assigned to California’s general obligation bonds from Baa1 to A1. The changes in those ratings reflect a recalibration by Fitch and Moody’s, as applicable, of their United States municipal ratings from a municipal scale to a global scale, and neither change reflects a change in credit quality. In January 2010, S&P lowered its rating on California’s general obligation bonds from A to A-minus, indicating that the State’s “… severe fiscal imbalance and impending recurrence of a cash deficiency …” were factors in reaching its decision. It is not possible to determine whether or the extent to which Moody’s, S&P, or Fitch will change its respective rating on California general obligation bonds in the future.

California Finances.

General Fund. The moneys of the State are segregated into the General Fund and over 1,000 other funds, including special, bond, and trust funds. The General Fund consists of revenues received by the State Treasury and not required by law to be credited to any other fund, as well as earnings from the investment of State moneys not allocable to another fund. The General Fund is the principal operating fund for the majority of governmental activities and is the depository of most of the major revenue sources of the State. The General Fund may be expended as a consequence of appropriation measures enacted by the California Legislature and approved by the Governor (including the annual Budget Act, as defined herein), as well as appropriations pursuant to various constitutional authorizations and initiative statutes.

Special Fund for Economic Uncertainties. The State maintains a Special Fund for Economic Uncertainties (“SFEU”), which is funded with General Fund revenues and which was established to protect the State from unforeseen revenue reductions and/or unanticipated expenditure increases. The State Controller may transfer amounts in the SFEU to the General Fund as necessary to meet cash needs of the General Fund and such transfers are characterized as “loans.” The State Controller is required to return moneys so transferred without payment of interest as soon as there are sufficient moneys in the General Fund. At the end of each fiscal year, the State Controller is required to transfer from the SFEU to the General Fund any amount necessary to eliminate any deficit in the General Fund.

The legislation creating the SFEU (California Government Code Section 16418) also contains a continuous appropriation authorizing the State Controller to transfer the unencumbered balance in the General Fund to the SFEU, as of the end of each fiscal year. However, if, at the end of any fiscal year in which it has been determined that there are revenues in excess of the amount that may be appropriated, as defined in subdivision (a) of Section 2 of Article XIII B of the California Constitution, this transfer shall be reduced by the amount of the excess revenues. The estimates of the transfer shall be made jointly by the State’s Legislative Analyst’s Office (the “LAO”) and the Department of Finance. For budgeting and accounting purposes, any appropriation made from the SFEU, other than appropriations contained in California Government Code Section 16418, is deemed an appropriation from the General Fund. For year-end reporting purposes, the State Controller is required to add the balance in the SFEU to the balance in the General Fund so as to show the total moneys then available for General Fund purposes.

 

D-5


Table of Contents

 

Budget Stabilization Account. The Balanced Budget Amendment (“Proposition 58”), approved in March 2004, created the Budget Stabilization Account (the “BSA”) as a second budgetary reserve. Beginning with fiscal year 2006-07, a specified portion of estimated annual General Fund revenues (reaching a ceiling of 3% by fiscal year 2008-09) will be transferred by the State Controller into the BSA no later than September 30 of each fiscal year unless the transfer is suspended or reduced as described below. These transfers will continue until the balance in the BSA reaches $8 billion or 5% of the estimated General Fund revenues for that fiscal year, whichever is greater. The annual transfer requirement will go back into effect whenever the balance falls below the $8 billion or the 5% target. The annual transfers can be suspended or reduced for a fiscal year by an executive order issued by the Governor no later than June 1 of the preceding fiscal year. Proposition 58 also provides that one-half of the annual transfers shall be used to retire Economic Recovery Bonds (“ERBs”) of the State issued pursuant to the California Economic Recovery Bond Act (“Proposition 57”), until a total of $5 billion has been used for that purpose. A total of $1.495 billion of the $5 billion amount has now been applied to the retirement of ERBs. See “State Indebtedness – Economic Recovery Bonds” below.

The 2007, 2008, and 2009 Budget Acts give the Director of Finance the authority to transfer moneys from the BSA back into the General Fund in an amount determined by the Director of Finance to be sufficient to ensure there is a prudent General Fund balance. Using this authority, the Director of Finance ordered the transfer of the entire balance of $1.495 billion from the BSA to the General Fund to address a fiscal emergency proclaimed by the Governor on January 10, 2008. Once moneys are transferred out of the BSA, pursuant to the authority, they will not be replenished by a future fiscal year’s annual transfer unless the California Legislature, by statute, directs additional funds to be transferred from the General Fund into the BSA. Separate from the foregoing process for a budgetary transfer, the BSA may be used to make temporary loans to the General Fund, which must be repaid when the General Fund has available cash, as described under “Inter-Fund Borrowings” below.

In light of the condition of the General Fund, the Governor issued an Executive Order on May 28, 2008, suspending the fiscal year 2008-09 transfer of $3.018 billion from the General Fund to the BSA, as had been proposed in the Governor’s proposed budget for fiscal year 2008-09, released on January 10, 2008 (the “2008-09 Governor’s Budget”). Due to a drastic decline in General Fund revenues, the Governor issued an Executive Order on May 29, 2009, suspending the fiscal year 2009-10 transfer estimated at approximately $2.8 billion from the General Fund to the BSA. The 2010-11 May Revision retained the January 10 proposal to suspend the fiscal year 2010-11 transfer estimated at approximately $2.7 billion from the General Fund to the BSA. There are currently no moneys in the BSA.

Inter-Fund Borrowing. Inter-fund borrowing is used to meet temporary imbalances of receipts and disbursements in the General Fund. In the event the General Fund is or will be exhausted, the State Controller is required to notify the Governor and the Pooled Money Investment Board (“PMIB”) (comprised of the Director of Finance, the State Treasurer, and the State Controller). The Governor may then order the State Controller to direct the transfer of all or any part of the moneys not needed in Special Funds to the General Fund, as determined by the PMIB. All money so transferred must be returned to the special fund from which it was transferred as soon as there is sufficient money in the General Fund to do so. Transfers cannot be made which will interfere with the objective for which such special fund was created, or from certain specific funds. In general, when moneys transferred to the General Fund in any fiscal year from any special fund pursuant to the inter-fund borrowing mechanism exceed 10% of the total additions to such special fund as shown in the statement of operations of the preceding fiscal year as set forth in the Budgetary/Legal Basis Annual Report of the State Controller, interest must be paid on such excess at a rate determined by the PMIB to be the current earning rate of the Pooled Money Investment Account (“PMIA”). This provision does not apply to temporary borrowings from the BSA or other accounts within the General Fund.

The amount of loans from the SFEU, the BSA, and other internal sources to the General Fund as of the end of any month is displayed in the most recent State Controller’s Statement of General Fund Cash Receipts and Disbursements, on the first page under “Borrowable Resources – Outstanding Loans.” Copies of the State

 

D-6


Table of Contents

Controller’s monthly Statement of General Fund Cash Receipts and Disbursements are available at the State Controller’s website. Neither the State Controller’s website, nor any of the information contained therein, is incorporated herein by this reference and no representation is made as to the accuracy of the information contained therein.

Any determination of whether a proposed borrowing from one of the Special Funds is permissible must be made with regard to the facts and circumstances existing at the time of the proposed borrowing. The State Attorney General has identified certain criteria relevant to such a determination. For instance, amounts in the Special Funds eligible for inter-fund borrowings are legally available to be transferred to the General Fund if a reasonable estimate of expected General Fund revenues, based upon legislation already enacted, indicates that such transfers can be paid from the General Fund promptly if needed by the Special Funds or within a short period of time if not needed. In determining whether this requirement has been met, the Attorney General has stated that consideration may be given to the fact that General Fund revenues are projected to exceed expenditures entitled to a higher priority than payment of internal transfers, i.e., expenditures for the support of the public school system and public institutions of higher education.

At the November 1998 election, voters approved Proposition 2. This proposition requires the General Fund to repay loans made from certain transportation special accounts (such as the State Highway Account) at least once per fiscal year, or up to 30 days after adoption of the annual Budget Act. Since the General Fund may re-borrow from the transportation accounts any time after the annual repayment is made, the proposition does not have any adverse impact on the State’s cash flow.

In connection with the adoption of the 2008 Budget Act, statutory changes sponsored by the Administration were enacted to clarify 18 existing State funds as borrowable resources for General Fund cash flow purposes. These funds increased the total amount of borrowable resources by approximately $3.5 billion as of September 2008. An additional $500 million of additional borrowable resources were previously made available in August 2008 as a result of administrative actions taken by the State Controller.

The February 2009 Budget Act also included clarification of an additional 19 funds as borrowable resources for General Fund cash flow purposes. These funds provide approximately $2 billion of additional borrowable cash to the General Fund.

In addition to temporary inter-fund cash flow borrowings described in this section, budgets enacted in the current and past fiscal years have included other budgetary transfers and long-term loans from special funds to the General Fund. In some cases, such budgetary loans and transfers have the effect of reducing internal borrowable resources.

The California Budget.

The Budget Process. California’s fiscal year begins on July 1 and ends on June 30 of the following year. The State’s General Fund budget operates on a legal basis, generally using a modified accrual system of accounting for its General Fund, with revenues credited in the period in which they are measurable and available and expenditures debited in the period in which the corresponding liabilities are incurred.

The California Constitution specifies that an annual budget shall be proposed by the Governor by January 10 of each year for the next fiscal year (the “Governor’s Budget”). Under State law, the annual proposed Governor’s Budget cannot provide for projected expenditures in excess of projected revenues for the ensuing fiscal year. State law also requires the Governor to update the Governor’s Budget projections and budgetary proposals by May 14 of each year (the “May Revision”). The May Revision is normally the basis for final negotiations between the Governor and Legislature to reach agreement on appropriations and other legislation to fund State government for the ensuing fiscal year (the “Budget Act”). The Budget Act must be approved by a two-thirds majority vote of each House of the California Legislature. As required by the Balanced Budget

 

D-7


Table of Contents

Amendment (“Proposition 58”), beginning with fiscal year 2004-05, the California Legislature may not pass a budget bill in which General Fund expenditures exceed estimated General Fund revenues and fund balances at the time of the passage and as set forth in the budget bill.

Under the State Constitution, money may be drawn from the State Treasury only through an appropriation made by law. The primary source of annual expenditure appropriations is the annual Budget Act as approved by the California Legislature and signed by the Governor. The Budget Act must be approved by a two-thirds majority vote of each House of the California Legislature. The Governor may reduce or eliminate specific line items in the Budget Act or any other appropriations bill without vetoing the entire bill. Such individual line-item vetoes are subject to override by a two-thirds majority vote of each House of the California Legislature. An initiative Constitutional amendment will be included on the November 2, 2010, election ballot that would reduce the required vote to adopt a budget bill to majority from two-thirds.

Appropriations also may be included in legislation other than the Budget Act. Except as noted in the previous paragraph and in the next sentence, bills containing General Fund appropriations must be approved by a two-thirds majority vote in each House of the California Legislature and be signed by the Governor. Bills containing appropriations for K-12 schools or community colleges (“K-14 education”) require only a simple majority vote. Continuing appropriations, available without regard to fiscal year, may also be provided by statute or the State Constitution.

Funds necessary to meet an appropriation are not required to be in the State Treasury at the time an appropriation is enacted; revenues may be appropriated in anticipation of their receipt.

Constraints on the Budget Process. Over the years, a number of laws and constitutional amendments have been enacted, often through voter initiatives, which have increased the difficulty of raising State taxes, restricted the use of the General Fund or special fund revenues, or otherwise limited the California Legislature and the Governor’s discretion in enacting budgets. Historic examples of provisions that make it more difficult to raise taxes include Proposition 13, passed in 1978, which, among other things, required that any change in State taxes enacted for the purpose of increasing revenues collected pursuant thereto, whether by increased rates or changes in computation, be approved by a two-thirds vote in each House of the California Legislature. Examples of provisions restricting the use of General Fund revenues are Proposition 98, passed in 1988, which mandates that a minimum amount of General Fund revenues be spent on local education, and Proposition 10, passed in 1998, which raised taxes on tobacco products and mandated how the additional revenues would be expended.

Recent Constitutional amendments approved by the voters have also affected the budget process. These include Proposition 58, approved in 2004, which requires the adoption of a balanced budget and restricts future borrowing to cover budget deficits; Proposition 49, approved in 2002, which requires the expansion of funding for before and after school programs; Proposition 63, approved in 2004, which imposes a surcharge on taxable income of more than $1 million and earmarks this funding for expanded mental heath services; Proposition 1A, approved in 2004, which limits the California Legislature’s power over local revenue sources; and Proposition 1A, approved in 2006, which limits the California Legislature’s ability to use sales taxes on motor vehicle fuels for any purpose other than transportation.

The 2009-10 Budget. The State’s budget for fiscal year 2009-10 was enacted in an unusual sequence. The 2008 Budget Act was one of the latest ever enacted, having been delayed until mid-September 2008 as a result of the difficulty of balancing the budget with reduced revenues, as declining economic conditions were already evident. The 2008 Budget Act, however, was based on revenue assumptions made in the spring of 2008, which proved to be greatly overstated by the time actual revenue results for September and October 2008 were received. With the financial market meltdown starting in September 2008, which resulted in massive federal assistance and caused large drops in stock market and other asset values and reductions in consumer spending, projections of tax revenues, which are heavily dependent on capital gains taxes and sales taxes, had to be dramatically reduced. In November 2008, the Governor announced that the 2008 Budget Act would be billions of dollars out of balance, and called several special sessions of the California Legislature to enact corrective actions.

 

D-8


Table of Contents

 

Because of strong disagreement in the California Legislature as to the amount of corrective actions that would be taken by tax increases versus expenditure reductions, a compromise was not reached until February 2009. At that time, the February 2009 Budget Package was enacted which included modifications to the 2008 Budget Act and the enactment, more than four months early, of a full budget act for fiscal year 2009-10.

Initial 2009 Budget Act. The Initial 2009 Budget Act was adopted by the California Legislature on February 19, 2009, along with a number of implementing measures, and signed by the Governor on February 20, 2009. In February 2009, the State enacted $36 billion in solutions to what was then estimated to be a $42 billion General Fund budget gap for the combined 2008-09 and 2009-10 fiscal years. It also provided for five budget-related measures that would have provided an estimated $6 billion in additional budget solutions, to be placed before the voters on May 19, 2009. These measures were all rejected by the voters.

Under the Initial 2009 Budget Act, based on then-current assumptions about the State’s financial circumstances, and assuming receipt of approximately $8.0 billion of federal stimulus funds to offset General Fund costs ($4.9 billion of which was assumed to be received in fiscal year 2009-10) and voter approval of various ballot measures, General Fund revenues and transfers were projected to increase 9.3%, from $89.4 billion in fiscal year 2008-09 to $97.7 billion in fiscal year 2009-10. The Initial 2009 Budget Act contained General Fund appropriations of $92.2 billion, compared to $94.1 billion in fiscal year 2008-09, a 2.0% decrease. The June 30, 2010, total reserve was projected to be $2.1 billion, an increase of $5.5 billion compared to the estimated June 30, 2009, reserve deficit of negative $3.4 billion. The Amended 2009 Budget Act reflected vetoes by the Governor of $1.305 billion in appropriations from the General Fund, special funds, and bond funds (including $957.2 million in General Fund appropriations).

After adoption of the Initial 2009 Budget Act, the State continued to experience significant declines in revenues and other financial pressures. On May 14, 2009, the Governor released the May Revision of the Initial 2009 Budget Act (as subsequently updated, “2009-10 May Revision”). Together with subsequent revisions, the 2009-10 May Revision identified a further budget shortfall through the 2009-10 fiscal year of approximately $24 billion.

Amended 2009 Budget Act. On July 24, 2009, the California Legislature approved the amendments to the Initial 2009 Budget Act and the Governor signed the Amended 2009 Budget Act on July 28, 2009. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included another $24 billion in solutions to address the further deterioration of the State’s fiscal situation identified in the 2009-10 May Revision. Under the Amended 2009 Budget Act, General Fund revenues and transfers were projected to increase 6.4%, from a revised $84.1 billion in fiscal year 2008-09 to $89.5 billion in fiscal year 2009-10. A significant element of this increase was projected to come from certain new revenues enacted in February 2008. See “New Revenues” below. The Amended 2009 Budget Act contained General Fund appropriations of $84.6 billion in fiscal year 2009-10, compared to $91.5 billion in fiscal year 2008-09, a 7.5% decrease. The June 30, 2010, total reserve was projected to be $500 million as compared to the revised June 30, 2009, reserve of negative $4.5 billion. Subsequent events after adoption of the Amended 2009 Budget Act exceeded the reserve such that the Administration, as of May 2010, projected that fiscal year 2009-10 would end with a negative balance of $6.8 billion at June 30, 2010. The discussion below describes some of the elements of the Amended 2009 Budget Act that could not be implemented as originally expected.

The Amended 2009 Budget Act contained the following major General Fund components:

1. Addressing the Deficit. The $60 billion in budget solutions adopted for the combined fiscal years 2008-09 and 2009-10 ($36 billion in solutions were adopted in February 2009 and $24 billion in July 2009) were wide-ranging and touched all three of the State’s major revenue sources (personal income taxes, corporation taxes, and sales and use taxes). Spending cuts were implemented in virtually every State program that receives General Fund support. The budget solutions included spending reductions of $31.0 billion (52% of total solutions). The spending reductions consisted primarily of reductions in education spending under Proposition 98 ($14.9 billion reduction), higher education ($3.3 billion reduction), employee compensation ($2.0 billion reduction), and reductions in other spending due to the use of redevelopment agency revenues and fund balances to pay costs that

 

D-9


Table of Contents

would otherwise be payable from the General Fund ($1.7 billion reduction). The budget solutions also included an estimated receipt of $8.0 billion (13% of total solutions) of federal stimulus funds to be used to offset General Fund expenditures. Additional solutions included $12.5 billion of tax increases (21% of total solutions), and $8.4 billion of other solutions (14% of total solutions). Significant elements of the budget solutions include:

 

   

Proposition 1A of 2004 Borrowing from Local Governments. The Amended 2009 Budget Act authorized the State to exercise its borrowing authority under Proposition 1A, approved in the November 2004 election (“Proposition 1A of 2004”) to borrow from local agencies up to 8% of their fiscal year 2008-09 property tax revenues. The State utilized this authority and the borrowing generated $1.998 billion that was used to offset General Fund costs for a variety of court, health, corrections, and K-12 programs. The borrowed sums must be repaid by the State, with interest, by June 15, 2013.

 

   

Redevelopment Agency Borrowing. The Amended 2009 Budget Act also contained a shift of $1.7 billion in local redevelopment agency funds to the State from current revenues and reserves in fiscal year 2009-10 and $350 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Under the Amended 2009 Budget Act, these revenues are ultimately shifted to schools that serve the redevelopment areas. An association of redevelopment agencies, and a group of counties, have filed separate suits to block this transfer that, if successful, could adversely affect the State’s financial condition. However, substantially all of the required transfers have been made. In May 2010, a trial court ruled in favor of the State in this challenge; the decision has been appealed. Subsequent to enactment of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, the California Legislature also passed clean-up legislation authorizing redevelopment agencies to borrow from prior-year balances in the low and moderate income housing funds to make the fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 payments.

 

   

Payroll Shift. One-time savings of $1.618 billion ($937.6 million General Fund) from shifting the payments for employee payroll covering the pay period ending June 30, 2010, to July for all entities that are paid through the Uniform State Payroll System. This shift will be repeated on an annual basis. This payment shift excludes the University of California, Community Colleges, staff of the California Legislature, the California Exposition and State Fair, and local trial courts.

 

   

State Compensation Insurance Fund Sale. One-time revenues of $1 billion from the sale of certain assets of the State Compensation Insurance Fund (“SCIF”). Because of pending litigation, the State no longer expects the sale of SCIF assets to occur in fiscal years 2009-10 or 2010-11.

2. Federal Stimulus. The Amended 2009 Budget Act assumed the receipt of at least $8 billion from the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (“ARRA”) to offset General Fund expenditures in fiscal years 2008-09 and 2009-10. Final estimates put this amount at approximately $8.7 billion. As of May 19, 2010, approximately $7.8 billion has been received by the State, and the remainder is expected by the end of June 2010.

3. Cash Flow Management. The deterioration of revenues resulted in a cash shortage in fiscal years 2008-09 and 2009-10. In order to manage cash flow and provide for timely payments of the State’s obligations, the Amended 2009 Budget Act included a number of cash solutions to better balance timing of receipts and disbursements. Further cash management solutions were adopted by the California Legislature as part of a special session in early 2010. The State expects to be able to meet its payment obligations in the final months of fiscal year 2009-10 through administrative actions.

4. Proposition 98. As of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, the minimum funding guarantee under Proposition 98 for K-14 education (the “Proposition 98 Guarantee”) for fiscal year 2009-10 was projected to be $50.4 billion, of which $35.0 billion was the General Fund portion. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, the Proposition 98 Guarantee for fiscal year 2009-10 was projected to be $49.9 billion, of which $34.7 billion was the General Fund portion.

5. K-12 Education. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $66.7 billion for K-12 education programs for fiscal year 2009-10, of which $35.0 billion was funded from the General Fund. As of the Amended 2009 Budget

 

D-10


Table of Contents

Act, total per-pupil expenditures were projected to be $11,259 in fiscal year 2009-10. Revised estimates in the 2010-11 May Revision reflected $65.9 billion for K-12 education programs for fiscal 2009-10, of which $35.9 billion was funded from the General Fund. Revised estimates in the 2010-11 May Revision reflected that total per-pupil expenditures were projected to be $11,121 in fiscal year 2009-10.

6. Higher Education. The Amended 2009 Budget Act reflected total funding of $20.9 billion, including $12.5 billion General Fund and Proposition 98 sources, for all major segments of higher education (excluding infrastructure and stem cell research), including approximately $2 billion from local property taxes that are included in the Proposition 98 Guarantee and expended on California Community Colleges. The 2010-11 May Revision included total funding of $20.5 billion for fiscal year 2009-10, including $12.6 billion General Fund and Proposition 98 sources for all major segments of higher education (excluding infrastructure and stem cell research).

7. Health and Human Services. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $24.8 billion in non-Proposition 98 General Fund expenditures for health and human service programs for fiscal year 2009-10. Due to the State’s severe fiscal shortfall, the Amended 2009 Budget Act included $5.8 billion in proposed General Fund expenditure reductions in health and human services programs in fiscal year 2009-10. Apart from the reduction in General Fund funding for these programs, the Amended 2009 Budget Act reflected significant General Fund relief for Health and Human Services programs resulting from the ARRA. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, non-Proposition 98 General Fund expenditures for health and human service programs for fiscal year 2009-10 were projected to be $24.9 billion.

8. Transportation Funding. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $1.441 billion of General Fund expenditures to fully fund local transportation programs under Proposition 42 in fiscal year 2009-10. Additionally, the Amended 2009 Budget Act directed $1.015 billion of funds from sales tax on fuels to offset costs of programs otherwise likely to be funded from the General Fund such as debt service on transit bonds and other transportation programs. Of this amount, approximately $878 million was for uses substantially similar to those that were the subject of litigation related to the 2008 Budget Act. On September 30, 2009, the State Supreme Court denied review of an adverse Court of Appeal decision in Shaw v. Chiang, which invalidated the use of these funds as appropriated. Consequently, these fuels sales taxes were retained in the public transportation account for appropriation. These funds are “borrowable” for short-term General Fund cash needs. Chapters 11 and 12, Statutes of 2010, were passed in the special session providing General Fund relief by eliminating the State sales tax on gas and increasing the State gas excise tax by a like amount. This effectively eliminates funding subject to the provisions of Proposition 42 and significantly reduces the funding going into the public transportation account, eliminating the so-called spillover allocation. Fuel excise tax revenues will be used to offset highway bond debt service thus providing increasing General Fund relief beginning in fiscal year 2009-10 and growing in future years. (Approximately $603 million of relief is projected for fiscal year 2010-11.) Remaining public transportation account funds and new diesel sales tax revenues are used to offset transit bond debt service allowable under the court ruling in fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11. After these two fiscal years, the statute provides for no further use of public transportation account for debt service offset. Additionally, $650 million of excise tax proceeds available from this legislation in fiscal year 2010-11 is proposed to be lent to the General Fund. This funding is available without diminishing previously anticipated transportation program levels and will be repaid in three years.

The special session transportation legislation provides for ongoing highway and local road funding similar in distribution to the former provisions that governed Proposition 42 funds (sales tax on gasoline). Increased funding is provided for the State Highway Operations and Protection Program (highway safety and rehabilitation projects, primarily) as well as local streets and roads and the State Transportation Improvement Program (capacity projects, primarily). The legislation provides approximately $350 million in ongoing annual transit operations grants with a one-time appropriation of $400 million for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11. Two initiatives have been submitted for the November 2010 ballot that, if either is approved, limit the ability of the State to implement the transportation legislation.

 

D-11


Table of Contents

 

9. Budget Stabilization Account. Pursuant to Proposition 58, the State normally would be required to set aside a specified portion of estimated annual General Fund revenues for fiscal year 2009-10 in the BSA for reserves that may be used to offset future shortfalls in the General Fund. Given the magnitude and urgency of the State’s ongoing financial stress, in accordance with Proposition 58, the Amended 2009 Budget Act suspended the transfer to the BSA for fiscal year 2009-10.

10. Prison Funding. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included $7.9 billion in General Fund expenditures for the California Department of Corrections and Rehabilitation (“CDCR”). In arriving at this figure, a total of $1.2 billion of savings for CDCR operations was assumed. Due to the delay in passage of legislation, and the failure of the California Legislature to adopt certain prison and parole reforms requested by the Governor, actual savings were approximately $587 million, with the result that CDCR costs were approximately $613 million higher than assumed in the Amended 2009 Budget Act, not including any changes as of the 2010-11 May Revision. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, CDCR costs in fiscal year 2009-10, excluding debt service and savings from employee compensation, were projected to exceed the level included in the Amended 2009 Budget Act by $906.6 million.

Fiscal Year 2009-10 Revised Estimates in the 2010-11 May Revision. The 2010-11 May Revision revised various revenue and expenditures estimates for fiscal year 2009-10. The 2010-11 May Revision projected, based on the various assumptions and proposals it contains, that the State would end fiscal year 2009-10 with a negative reserve of $6.8 billion, compared to the estimate of a negative $5.4 billion reserve at the time of the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget.

The 2010-11 May Revision reflected a net increase of $493.1 million in the General Fund beginning balance at the start of fiscal year 2009-10, since the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget. This change in the starting balance is primarily due to the following components:

 

   

$317.4 million increase in fiscal year 2009-10 Corporate Income Tax accruals;

 

   

$184.1 million increase in fiscal year 2008-09 Proposition 98 savings.

As of the 2010-11 May Revision, General Fund revenues and transfers for fiscal year 2009-10 were projected at a revised $86.5 billion, a decrease of $1.563 billion compared with the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget estimates. This change is primarily made up of the following components:

 

   

$2.619 billion decrease in personal income tax;

 

   

$816 million increase in sales and use tax;

 

   

$240 million increase in other revenues and transfers.

Under the 2010-11 May Revision, General Fund expenditures for fiscal year 2009-10 were projected at $86.5 million, an increase of $373 million compared with the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget estimates. This increase in expenditures is primarily attributable to an increase in Proposition 98 expenditures of $1.2 billion, and a decrease in non-Proposition 98 expenditures of $803.3 million. The increase in Proposition 98 expenditures is primarily due to a decrease in Proposition 1A and redevelopment agency offset.

The non-Proposition 98 expenditure decrease is due primarily to the combined effects of an $814 million increase in health and human services expenditures, a decrease of $367.9 million in borrowing costs, increased federal funds offsets of $430.5 million, and an increase in Proposition 1A and redevelopment agency offsets of $890.2 million (previously budgeted as offset to Proposition 98 expenditures).

Budget Risks. The Amended 2009 Budget Act was based on a variety of assumptions. As described above, actual circumstances or conditions in fiscal year 2009-10 have differed from such assumptions in material respects, and the State’s financial condition may continue to be adversely impacted.

 

D-12


Table of Contents

 

As of June 13, 2010, budget risks still remaining for the 2009-10 fiscal year included, but were not limited to, the following:

 

   

Actual revenues through the end of fiscal year 2009-10 may be below projected amounts.

 

   

Delays in or inability of the State to implement budget solutions, or increased costs, as a result of litigation. The following cases dealing with elements of the Amended 2009 Budget Act are still pending:

 

   

There are almost three dozen separate cases dealing with the Governor’s furlough of State employees ($1.3 billion potential General Fund impact). The State Supreme Court has granted review of several cases, and several others are pending before the Court of Appeal. (In March 2010, the California Legislature passed legislation exempting from furlough State workers paid from sources other than the General Fund. The Governor vetoed this bill.); and

 

   

Potential court orders for the State to expend moneys for prison healthcare improvements, in excess of the amounts included in the Amended 2009 Budget Act.

Although appeals are continuing, the Governor has prevailed at lower court levels on several cases challenging aspects of the Amended 2009 Budget Act, including his vetoes of appropriations in July 2009 and the transfer of redevelopment agency moneys.

New Revenues. The Amended 2009 Budget Act included several major changes in General Fund revenues described below. The Amended 2009 Budget Act did not include any additional tax increases over those provided for pursuant to the Initial 2009 Budget Act, though it did include certain tax law changes intended to increase tax compliance and accelerate some revenues that were not in the Initial 2009 Budget Act.

As part of the Initial 2009 Budget Act passed in February 2009, the following tax and fee increases were adopted:

 

   

Temporary Sales Tax Increase. Effective April 1, 2009, the General Fund sales and use tax rate was temporarily increased by 1 cent, from 5% to 6% . This tax increase will be in effect through June 30, 2011. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this tax law change was expected to generate additional sales tax revenues of $4.299 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $4.223 billion in fiscal year 2010-11 for the General Fund.

 

   

Vehicle License Fees. Effective May 19, 2009, vehicle license fees were temporarily increased from 0.65% to 1.15% with 0.35% going to the General Fund and 0.15% going to the Local Safety and Protection Account for local law enforcement grant programs previously funded from the General Fund. Vehicle license fees apply to the value of the vehicle (initially its market value and then subject to a standard depreciation schedule). This increase will remain in effect through June 30, 2011. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this law change was expected to generate additional revenues of approximately $1.386 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $1.472 billion in fiscal year 2010-11.

 

   

Personal Income Tax Surcharge. The Initial 2009 Budget Act provided for a temporary addition of 0.25% to each personal income tax rate for tax years 2009 and 2010. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this change is expected to generate approximately $2.707 billion of additional General Fund revenues in fiscal year 2009-10 and $1.073 billion in fiscal year 2010-11.

 

   

Dependent Exemption Credit Reduction. The Initial 2009 Budget Act included a temporary reduction in the personal income tax-exemption credit for dependents to the amount provided for the personal credit for tax years 2009 and 2010 from $309 to $99 (tax year 2008 values). As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this change was expected to generate approximately $1.429 billion of additional General Fund revenues in fiscal year 2009-10 and $700 million in fiscal year 2010-11.

 

D-13


Table of Contents

 

The Amended 2009 Budget Act, passed in July 2009, included tax law changes affecting the General Fund as described below:

 

   

Non-Retailer Registration for Use Tax. Under current law in 2009, non-retailers – those who do not sell tangible personal property – were not required to register with the State Board of Equalization (“BOE”). This law change requires non-retailers that hold a business license and have at least $100,000 in gross receipts to register with the BOE and submit a return that details purchases made during the year that were subject to the use tax yet for which no use tax was paid. This law change was expected to increase General Fund sales and use tax revenue by $26 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $123 million in fiscal year 2010-11, with increasing amounts thereafter.

 

   

Accelerate Estimated Tax Payments. Under current law in 2009, individuals and corporations were required to pay 30% each with the first two estimated payments, and 20% each for the last two estimated payments. Under this law change, beginning with the 2010 tax year, the first quarter estimated payment percentage will remain at 30% payable on April 15, the second quarter will increase to 40% payable on June 15, the third estimated payment will be eliminated, and the fourth quarter estimated payment will increase from 20% to 30% payable on December 15 for corporations and January 15 for individuals. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this law change was expected to accelerate $1.295 billion into fiscal year 2009-10 ($672 million in personal income tax receipts and $623 million in corporate tax receipts) and $98 million in fiscal year 2010-11 ($60 million in personal income tax receipts and $38 million in corporate tax receipts).

 

   

Accelerate Wage Withholding. This tax law change increased current wage withholding rates by 10% and, as of the 2010-11 May Revision, was expected to accelerate $1.6 billion of personal income tax receipts into fiscal year 2009-10.

 

   

Require Backup Withholding. Under current federal law, gambling winnings reported on Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) Form W2G and payments made by banks and businesses reported on various IRS 1099 forms may be subject to backup withholding on those payments. Payments reported on IRS 1099 forms include payments to independent contractors, rents, commissions, and royalty payments. This law change conformed State law to federal law by requiring a withholding rate of 7% for State purposes whenever it is required for federal purposes. As of the 2010-11 May Revision, this law change was expected to increase personal income tax revenues by $32 million in fiscal year 2009-10 followed by an additional $31 million in fiscal year 2010-11.

State Office Building Sales Program. Pursuant to legislation enacted in 2009, the State Department of General Services (“DGS”) has solicited proposals for the disposition of 11 State office properties, through a sale, lease, or a sale with an option to lease back. A large number of bids were received in April 2010 and the DGS is still conducting due diligence on the bids received. Once a preferred buyer has been identified, DGS will notify the California Legislature. Under current law, the California Legislature has 30 days to review the sales agreement, but a bill adopted unanimously by the Assembly on June 3, 2010 (AB 2605) would require affirmative California Legislative approval for the building sale to proceed. This bill is pending in the Senate. At this time, the amount of potential revenue from the proposed sale is unknown. The 2010-11 May Revision assumed approximately $600 million of one-time net revenues to the General Fund over the next three years from the sale. (Approximately $1.1 billion of other sale proceeds would have to retire existing debt used to construct some of the buildings.)

State Indebtedness.

The California Treasurer (the “Treasurer”) is responsible for the sale of debt obligations of the State and its various authorities and agencies. The State has always paid when due the principal of and interest on its general obligation bonds, general obligation commercial paper notes, lease revenue obligations, and short-term obligations, including revenue anticipation notes and revenue anticipation warrants.

 

D-14


Table of Contents

 

General Obligation Bonds. The State Constitution prohibits the creation of general obligation indebtedness of the State unless a bond measure is approved by a majority of the electorate voting at a general election or a direct primary. General obligation bond acts provide a continuing appropriation from the General Fund of all debt service payments on general obligation bonds, subject only to the prior application of moneys in the General Fund to the support of the public school system and public institutions of higher education. Under the State Constitution, the appropriation to pay debt service on the general obligation bonds cannot be repealed until the principal and interest on the bonds has been paid. Certain general obligation bond programs, called “self-liquidating bonds,” receive revenues from specified sources so that moneys from the General Fund are not expected to be needed to pay debt service, but the General Fund is liable as a back-up if the specified revenue source is not sufficient. The principal self-liquidating bond programs are the ERBs, supported by a special sales tax, and veterans general obligation bonds, supported by mortgage repayments from housing loans made to military veterans. General obligation bonds are typically authorized for infrastructure and other capital improvements at the State and local level. Pursuant to the State Constitution, general obligation bonds cannot be used to finance State budget deficits (except as already authorized by ERBs, as described below).

As of May 1, 2010, the State had outstanding $78,439,139,000 aggregate principal amount of long-term general obligation bonds, of which $68,917,429,000 were payable primarily from the General Fund, and $9,521,710,000 were “self-liquidating” bonds payable first from other special revenue funds. As of May 1, 2010, there were unused voter authorizations for the future issuance of $42,909,259,000 of long-term general obligation bonds, some of which may first be issued as commercial paper notes (see “General Obligation Commercial Paper Program” below). Of this unissued amount, $1,331,210,000 is for general obligation bonds payable first from other revenue sources.

Legislation enacted November 4, 2009, authorizes submission to the voters at the statewide election on November 2, 2010, of a ballot measure to approve the issuance of $11.14 billion in general obligation bonds for a wide variety of purposes relating to improvement of California’s water supply systems, drought relief, and groundwater protection. The bill specifies that not more than one-half of the bonds may be sold before July 1, 2015. Additional bond measures may be included on the November 2, 2010, election ballot.

Variable Rate General Obligation Bonds. The general obligation bond law permits the State to issue as variable rate indebtedness up to 20% of the aggregate amount of long-term general obligation bonds outstanding. As of May 1, 2010, the State had outstanding $5,294,440,000 principal amount of variable rate general obligation bonds (which includes a portion of the ERBs described below), representing approximately 6.7% of the State’s total outstanding general obligation bonds as of that date. Under State law, except for the ERBs, the State must pay the principal of any general obligation bonds that are subject to optional or mandatory tender, and that are not remarketed or, if applicable, purchased by financial institutions that provide liquidity support to the State. The State has not entered into any interest rate hedging contracts in relation to any of its variable rate general obligation bonds, and it no longer has any auction rate bonds outstanding.

General Obligation Commercial Paper Program. Pursuant to legislation enacted in 1995, voter-approved general obligation indebtedness may be issued either as long-term bonds or, for some but not all bond issues, as commercial paper notes. Commercial paper notes may be renewed or may be refunded by the issuance of long-term bonds. It is currently the State’s policy to use commercial paper notes to provide flexibility for bond programs, such as to provide interim funding of voter-approved projects and to facilitate refunding of variable rate bonds into fixed rate bonds. Prior to late 2008, commercial paper notes were used primarily to repay internal loans from the PMIA, as a step toward issuance of long-term bonds. However, the internal loan program is no longer being used for general obligation bond programs and all such loans have been repaid from sale of long-term general obligation bonds. Pursuant to the terms of the bank credit agreement presently in effect, the general obligation commercial paper program may have up to $2 billion in aggregate principal amount at any time. This maximum amount may be increased or decreased in the future. As of May 7, 2010, $1,292,170,000 aggregate principal amount of general obligation commercial paper notes were outstanding, most of which relates back to retirement of PMIA loan expenditures in 2008. Commercial paper notes are not included in the calculation of permitted variable rate indebtedness described under “Variable Rate General Obligation Bonds.”

 

D-15


Table of Contents

 

Bank Arrangements. In connection with the letters of credit or other credit facilities obtained by the State in connection with variable rate obligations and the commercial paper program, the State has entered into a number of reimbursement agreements or other credit agreements with a variety of financial institutions. These agreements include various representations and covenants of the State, and the terms (including interest rates and repayment schedules) by which the State would be required to repay any drawings (including drawings resulting from any failed remarketings) on the respective letters of credit or other credit enhancement to which such credit agreements relate. To the extent that any variable rate obligations cannot be remarketed over an extended period (whether due to reductions in the credit ratings of the institution providing credit enhancement or other factors), interest payable by the State pursuant to the reimbursement agreement or credit agreement would generally increase over current market levels relating to the variable rate obligations, and the principal repayment period would generally be shorter (typically less than five years) than the repayment period otherwise applicable to the variable rate obligation. On occasion the State’s variable rate obligations have not been remarketed resulting in draws on the applicable credit facilities.

During 2009, the State took a number of actions regarding its bank credit arrangements, including extending existing letter of credit facilities and converting standby purchase agreements to letters of credit for some of its floating rate ERBs and for its commercial paper program. The makeup of some of the State’s credit facilities was also revised with the deletion or substitution of banks. The State faces the need to renew approximately $1.37 billion of letters of credit for several series of variable rate general obligation bonds in November and December 2010.

Lease Revenue Obligations. In addition to general obligation bonds, the State has acquired and constructed capital facilities through the use of lease revenue borrowing (also referred to as lease-purchase borrowing). Under these arrangements, the State Public Works Board, another state or local agency, or a joint powers authority issued bonds to pay for the construction of facilities such as office buildings, university buildings, courthouses, or correctional institutions. These facilities are leased to a State agency, the California State University, the University of California, or the Judicial Council under a long-term lease that provides the source of payment of the debt service on the lease revenue bonds. In some cases, there was not a separate bond issue, but a trustee directly created certificates of participation in the State’s lease obligation, which were then marketed to investors. Under applicable court decisions, such lease arrangements do not constitute the creation of “indebtedness” within the meaning of the State Constitutional provisions that require voter approval. For purposes of this Statement of Additional Information, the terms “lease revenue obligation,” “lease revenue financing,” “lease-purchase obligation” or “lease-purchase” means, principally, bonds or certificates of participation for capital facilities where the lease payments providing the security are payable from the operating budget of the respective lessees, which are primarily, but not exclusively, derived from the General Fund, and also includes revenue bonds for a State energy efficiency program secured by payments made by various State agencies under energy service contracts. The State had $10,071,627,519 in lease revenue obligations outstanding as of May 1, 2010. The State Public Works Board, which is authorized to sell lease revenue bonds, had $9,834,701,000 authorized and unissued as of May 1, 2010.

Non-Recourse Debt. Certain State agencies and authorities issue revenue obligations for which the General Fund has no liability. Revenue bonds represent obligations payable from State revenue-producing enterprises and projects, which are not payable from the General Fund, and conduit obligations payable only from revenues paid by private users of facilities financed by the revenue bonds. The enterprises and projects include transportation projects, various public works projects, public and private educational facilities (including the California State University and University of California systems), housing, health facilities, and pollution control facilities. State agencies and authorities had approximately $56 billion aggregate principal amount of revenue bonds and notes, which are non-recourse to the General Fund outstanding as of December 31, 2009.

Build America Bonds. In February 2009, the United States Congress enacted certain new municipal bond provisions as part of the ARRA. One provision allows municipal issuers such as the State to issue “Build America Bonds” (“BABs”) for new infrastructure investments. BABs are bonds whose interest is subject to

 

D-16


Table of Contents

federal income tax, but the U.S. Treasury will repay to the State an amount equal to 35% of the interest cost on any BABs issued during 2009 and 2010. This results in a net interest expense lower than what the State would have had to pay for tax-exempt bonds of similar maturity. The subsidy payments from general obligation bonds are General Fund revenues to the State, while subsidy payments for lease revenue bonds are deposited into a fund that is made available to the State Public Works Board for any lawful purpose. In neither instance are the subsidy payments specifically pledged to repayment of the BABs to which they relate. The cash subsidy payment with respect to the BABs, to which the State is entitled, is treated by the IRS as a refund of a tax credit and such refund may be offset by the U.S. Department of the Treasury by any liability of the State payable to the federal government, including in respect of any internal revenue tax (including any interest and penalties), past due child support, past due and legally enforceable debt due federal agencies, unemployment compensation debts, and past due legally enforceable State income tax debts.

Starting in April 2009 and through April 30, 2010, the State has issued a significant amount of BABs, including $10.39 billion of general obligation bonds and $551 million of lease revenue bonds. The aggregate amount of the subsidy payments to be received from fiscal year 2010-11 through the maturity of these bonds (mostly 20 to 30 years) is approximately $7.46 billion for the general obligation BABs and $338 million for the lease revenue BABs. The Obama Administration has proposed making the BABs program permanent, although at a lower subsidy rate for future issuances. In late May 2010 the U.S. House of Representatives passed a bill (H.R. 4213) that extends the BABs program for two years at successively lower subsidy rates, but higher than those proposed by the Obama Administration; this proposal has not yet been acted on by the Senate.

Future Issuance Plans; General Fund Debt Ratio. Between November 2006 and August 2009, voters and the California Legislature authorized more than $60 billion of new general obligation bonds and lease revenue bonds. This new authorization substantially increased the current amount of such General Fund-supported debt outstanding to more than $79 billion, while still leaving authorized and unissued approximately $51 billion of such bonds as of May 1, 2010. In order to address the expenditure needs for these new authorizations, along with those that existed before 2006, the State has increased the volume of issuance of both of these categories of bonds substantially, compared to previous years, starting in fiscal year 2007-08. The amounts and timing of future issuance of general obligation and lease revenue bonds will depend on a variety of factors, including the actual timing of expenditure needs for the various programs for which such bonds are to be issued, the amount and timing of interim financing provided to the programs, the interest rate and other market conditions at the time of issuance, and the timing and amounts of additional general obligation bonds or lease revenue bonds that may be approved.

Disruptions in financial markets and uncertainties about the State’s budget condition caused significant disruptions in the State’s bond issuance program during fiscal year 2008-09. Because of these factors, the State did not issue any new general obligation bonds between July 2008 and March 2009. In March 2009, the State it issued $6.54 billion of new tax-exempt bonds, the largest new money general obligation bond issue in the State’s history (excluding ERBs). A few weeks later, the State took advantage of the new federal rules to issue $6.86 billion of federally taxable general obligations bonds, of which $5.3 billion were BABs. A significant part of the over $13 billion of bonds issued in the spring of 2009 was used to retire internal borrowings used to fund construction projects, which had built up because of the long hiatus in bond issuance. An additional $6.546 billion of tax-exempt and taxable general obligation bonds ($2.66 billion BABs) were issued in the fall of 2009, together with $1.549 billion of lease revenue bonds ($250 million BABs).

The combination of unusual circumstances resulted in public offerings of a record $19.7 billion of general obligation bonds during calendar year 2009. Through May 31, 2010, the State has issued $5.9 billion of general obligation bonds and $721 million of lease revenue bonds in calendar year 2010. The 2010-11 May Revision projected issuance of approximately $15.8 billion of general obligation and lease revenue bonds in that fiscal year. These are preliminary estimates, and the actual amount of bonds sold in fiscal year 2010-11 will depend on many factors, including more detailed review of program needs, budget priorities, and market conditions.

 

D-17


Table of Contents

 

Based on the current Department of Finance projections of program expenditure needs, without taking into account any future authorizations that may occur, the State Treasurer has estimated that the aggregate amount of outstanding debt supported by the General Fund, including general obligation, lease revenue, and Proposition 1A bonds, based on current voter and legislative authorizations, is estimated to peak at approximately $111.3 billion by fiscal year 2014-15, compared to the current outstanding amount of approximately $80.8 billion. The annual debt service costs on this amount of debt is estimated by the State Treasurer to increase to approximately $9.93 billion in fiscal year 2012-13 compared to approximately $6.09 billion budgeted in fiscal year 2009-10. The projected amounts for fiscal year 2010-11 through 2011-12 include the interest, and for fiscal year 2012-13, the interest and principal payable on the $1.90 billion of bonds issued in connection with Proposition 1A. After fiscal year 2012-13, projected peak debt service is $9.97 billion in fiscal year 2017-18. (These estimates do not include ERBs, described below, or veterans general obligation bonds supported by mortgage repayments from housing loans made to military veterans, nor do they take into account potential benefits from future refunding opportunities.)

In light of the substantial drop in General Fund revenues since fiscal year 2007-08, and the projections of substantial new bond sales in the future, the ratio of debt service on general obligation, lease revenue, and the Proposition 1A bonds supported by the General Fund, to annual General Fund revenues and transfers (the “General Fund Debt Ratio”) can be expected to increase significantly in future years. Based on the revised estimates contained in the 2010-11 May Revision, in fiscal year 2009-10, the General Fund Debt Ratio was estimated to equal approximately 7.03%. Based on the assumed debt issuance referred to in the preceding paragraph, and the assumed growth in General Fund revenues and transfers contained in the 2010-11 May Revision, through fiscal year 2013-14, the State’s General Fund Debt Ratio is projected to peak at 10.58% in fiscal year 2012-13, the year in which the Proposition 1A bonds mature. In the fiscal year following the maturity of the Proposition 1A bonds, fiscal year 2013-14, the State’s General Fund Debt Ratio is projected to decline to 9.34%. The State’s General Fund Debt Ratio after fiscal year 2013-14 will depend on the State’s future General Fund revenues, which will in turn depend on a variety of factors including but not limited to economic, population, and inflation growth. Based on the State’s current debt issuance projections and an assumed combined average annual General Fund revenue growth rate of between 2% to 5%, the State’s General Fund Debt Ratio in fiscal year 2019-20 is projected to range from 7.26% to 8.67%. The General Fund Debt Ratio is calculated based on actual gross debt service, without adjusting for receipts from the U.S. Treasury for the State’s current outstanding general obligation and lease revenue BABs, and an assumed interest rate of 6.25% and 6.75% for future issuances of general obligation and lease revenue bonds, respectively. The actual General Fund Debt Ratio in future fiscal years will depend on a variety of factors, including actual debt issuance (which may include additional issuance approved in the future by the California Legislature and, for general obligation bonds, the voters), actual interest rates, debt service structure, and actual General Fund revenues and transfers.

Economic Recovery Bonds. Proposition 57 was approved by the voters on March 2, 2004. Proposition 57 authorized the issuance of up to $15 billion in ERBs to finance the negative General Fund reserve balance as of June 30, 2004, and other General Fund obligations undertaken prior to June 30, 2004. Repayment of the ERBs is secured by a pledge of revenues from a one-quarter cent increase in the State’s sales and use tax that became effective July 1, 2004. In addition, as voter-approved general obligation bonds, the ERBs are secured by the State’s full faith and credit and payable from the General Fund in the event the dedicated sales and use tax revenue is insufficient to repay the bonds.

In May and June 2004, the State issued $10.896 billion principal amount of ERBs, resulting in the deposit of net proceeds to the General Fund of approximately $11.254 billion. In order to relieve cash flow and budgetary shortfalls identified in the 2008-09 Governor’s Budget, the State issued approximately $3.179 billion of additional ERBs on February 14, 2008, generating net proceeds of $3.313 billion, which were transferred to the General Fund. No further ERBs can be issued under Proposition 57, except for refunding bonds that may be issued in the future. (The Department of Finance had determined that the full $15 billion voter authorization could not be issued because of the previous repayment of certain June 30, 2004 obligations eligible for financing pursuant to Proposition 57.)

 

D-18


Table of Contents

 

Because of the sharp reduction in taxable sales as a result of the recent economic recession, the Special Sales Tax Revenues (“SSTRs”) collected from the one-quarter cent tax dedicated to repayment of the ERB debt decreased to a level that did not provide adequate coverage above the required debt service amounts for the 2004 and 2008 ERBs. This resulted in downgrades of the ratings of the ERBs and would have required debt service to be paid from reserve funds for at least some period of time. In order to restore adequate coverage, the State restructured the ERB debt through the issuance of approximately $3.435 billion ERB refunding bonds on November 5, 2009. The restructuring reduced annual debt service costs to come into alignment with reduced tax revenues, with a coverage target of at least 1.3 times. The ratings for all ERBs have been raised to levels above the State’s general obligation bond ratings.

Three different sources of funds are required to be applied to the early retirement (generally by purchase or redemption) of ERBs: (i) all proceeds from the dedicated quarter cent sales tax in excess of the amounts needed, on a semi-annual basis, to pay debt service and other required costs of the bonds, (ii) all proceeds from the sale of specified surplus State property, and (iii) 50% of each annual deposit, up to $5 billion in the aggregate, of deposits in the BSA. As of January 2010, funds from these sources have been used for early retirement of approximately $3.5 billion of bonds during fiscal years 2005-06 through 2009-10, including $1.495 billion that was transferred from the BSA in fiscal year 2006-07 ($472 million) and fiscal year 2007-08 ($1.023 billion). The State reported that approximately $122 million of surplus tax revenues will be used to retire ERBs on June 24, 2010.

The Governor suspended each of the fiscal years 2008-09, 2009-10, and 2010-11 BSA transfers due to the condition of the General Fund.

Tobacco Settlement Revenue Bonds. In 1998, the State signed a settlement agreement (the “Master Settlement Agreement” or “MSA”) with the four major cigarette manufacturers (the “participating manufacturers” or “PMs”). Under the MSA, the PMs agreed to make payments to the State in perpetuity, which payments at the time were predicted to total approximately $25 billion (subject to adjustments) over the first 25 years. Under a separate Memorandum of Understanding, half of the payments made by the cigarette manufacturers is paid to the State and half to local governments. The specific amount to be received by the State and local governments is subject to adjustment. Details in the MSA require reduction of the PMs’ payments for decreases in cigarette shipment volumes by the PMs, payments owed to certain “Previously Settled States” and certain other types of offsets. However, settlement payments are adjusted upward each year by at least 3% for inflation, compounded annually.

State law enacted in 2002 (the “Tobacco Securitization Law”) authorized the establishment of a special purpose trust to purchase the tobacco assets and to issue revenue bonds secured by the tobacco settlement revenues received beginning in the 2003-04 fiscal year. Legislation in 2003 amended the Tobacco Securitization Law to authorize a “back-up state guaranty” that requires the Governor to request an appropriation from the General Fund in the annual Budget Act to pay debt service and other related costs of the tobacco settlement revenue bonds secured by the second 2003 sale of tobacco settlement revenues when such tobacco settlement revenues are insufficient. The California Legislature is not obligated to make any General Fund appropriation.

In 2003, two separate sales of these assets financed with revenue bonds (the “2003 Bonds”) produced approximately $4.75 billion in proceeds, which were transferred to the General Fund. In 2005 and 2007, the State refunded all of the original 2003 Bonds, generating additional proceeds of approximately $1.783 billion, which were also transferred to the General Fund. The back-up State guaranty was applied to only the second 2003 sale of bonds and was continued when those bonds were refunded in 2005 (the “2005 Refunding Bonds”). The back-up State guaranty now applies to the $3.14 billion of 2005 Refunding Bonds.

The MSA provides for a potential reduction to the PMs’ payments under specified conditions relating to the loss of market share to non-participating manufacturers (“NPMs”). This potential reduction is called an “NPM adjustment.” The State disputes the PMs’ right to an NPM adjustment for any year. The MSA also allows the

 

D-19


Table of Contents

PMs to withhold any portion of their annual payments that is disputed, until such time as the dispute is resolved. Since 2006, the annual amount of revenues received by the State has incurred some level of withholding based on the PMs’ assertion of their right to receive an NPM adjustment as is reflected in the table below. Nevertheless, the annual amount of tobacco settlement revenues received to date has been in excess of the required debt service payments.

 

Year of Scheduled Payment

   Approximate NPM Adjustment Withheld  

2006

   $ 50.9 million   

2007

     44.0 million   

2008

     33.9 million

2009

     32.8 million   

2010

     35.3 million   

 

* In February 2009, these funds were released and remitted to the State as part of the NPM arbitration negotiations.

Source: State of California, Department of Finance.

The State Attorney General is pursuing, in a multi-state arbitration proceeding, a determination compelling the PMs to pay the full amount scheduled, given that the State asserts that it has been diligently enforcing the statute governing the NPMs, as required in the MSA.

Tobacco settlement revenue bonds are neither general nor legal obligations of the State or any of its political subdivisions and neither the faith and credit nor the taxing power nor any other assets or revenues of the State or of any political subdivision is or shall be pledged to the payment of any such bonds; provided that, in connection with the issuance of the 2005 Refunding Bonds, the State covenanted to request the California Legislature for a General Fund appropriation in the event tobacco settlement revenues fall short. Tobacco settlement revenues have been sufficient to pay debt service with respect to the tobacco settlement revenue bonds, and therefore the State’s covenant to request an appropriation has never been invoked.

Obligations In Connection with Proposition 1A of 2004. The Amended 2009 Budget Act provided for State borrowing, pursuant to Proposition 1A, of approximately $1.998 billion of local property tax revenues. In accordance with Proposition 1A, the State is required to repay such revenues no later than June 2013. Legislation implementing the borrowing in the Amended 2009 Budget Act provided authority to local governments to sell their right to receive the State repayment to a joint powers authority (JPA) and for the JPA to issue bonds backed by the State’s repayment obligation. The repayment obligation includes interest and issuance costs for the JPA bonds.

On November 19, 2009, the California Statewide Communities Development Authority, a JPA, issued $1,895,000,000 of bonds that are secured by the State’s obligation to make these payments to approximately 1,300 local governments, representing approximately 95% of the State’s total borrowing from local governments. The 2010-11 Governor’s Budget includes $90.8 million General Fund for the interest payments that will be incurred in that fiscal year. In accordance with the authorizing legislation, these bonds will be repaid by June 15, 2013. In addition, for the obligations to entities not participating in the JPA bond program (which are $103 million in principal amount), the Director of Finance has set an interest rate of 2% per annum.

 

D-20


Table of Contents

 

Cash Flow Borrowing. As part of its cash management program, the State has regularly issued short-term obligations to meet cash flow needs. The following table shows the amount of RANs issued in the past five fiscal years and through June 13, 2010, in fiscal year 2009-10:

State of California Revenue Anticipation Notes Issued

Fiscal Years 2004-05 to 2009-10

(Dollars in Billions)

 

Fiscal Year

    

Type

     Principal Amount       

Date of Issue

    

Maturity Date

2004-05

     Notes Series A - D      $ 6.0             October 6, 2004      June 30, 2005

2005-06

     Notes        3.0             November 10, 2005      June 30, 2006

2006-07

     Notes        1.5             October 3, 2006      June 29, 2007

2007-08

     Notes        7.0             November 1, 2007      June 30, 2008

2008-09

     Notes Series A-1        1.2             October 23, 2008      May 20, 2009
     Notes Series A-2        3.8             October 23, 2008      June 22, 2009
     Notes Series B-1        0.5             March 23, 2009      June 23, 2009

2009-10

     Interim Notes        1.5             August 27, 2009      October 5, 2009*
     Notes Series A-1        2.825         September 29, 2009      May 25, 2010
     Note Series A-2        5.975         September 29, 2009      June 23, 2010

 

* Repaid on September 29, 2009 with a portion of the 2009-10 Notes Series A.

Source: State of California, Office of the State Treasurer.

Indirect, Nonpublic, or Contingent Obligations.

 

   

Flood Litigation Judgment. In 2005, the State settled a lawsuit arising from liability for past flood damages through a stipulated judgment in the amount of $428 million, which provided for the State to make annual payments of $42.8 million, plus interest, for 10 years; the payments are subject to annual appropriation by the California Legislature. The California Legislature has included the required annual installment in each budget act since the settlement was approved. This matter is not treated as a “debt” of the State for any legal or constitutional purposes.

 

   

Unemployment Insurance Fund Borrowing. Commencing in January 2011, the State will be required to pay interest payments on loans made by the federal government to the State Unemployment Insurance (UI) Fund.

 

   

Special Fund Borrowings. As has been described in connection with various budget acts and current budget proposals, the General Fund has or may incur legal obligations to repay various Special Funds, or to repay schools or other local governments, for borrowings that have been treated as providing revenue to the General Fund. These loans may, in some cases, be further extended by the California Legislature. Such loans are not treated as “debt” for any legal or constitutional purposes.

 

   

Office of Statewide Health Planning and Development Guarantees. Pursuant to a law created in 1969, the Office of Statewide Health Planning and Development (“OSHPD”) insures loans and bond issues for construction and renovation projects for nonprofit and publicly-owned healthcare facilities. The program (commonly called “Cal-Mortgage Loan Insurance”) is currently authorized in statute to insure up to $3 billion for health facility projects. State law established the Health Facility Construction Loan Insurance Fund (“Fund”) as a trust fund that is continuously appropriated and may only be used for program purposes. The Fund is used as a depository of fees and insurance premiums and is the initial source of funds used to pay administrative costs of the program and shortfalls resulting from defaults by insured borrowers. If the Fund were unable to make payment on an insured loan or bond, State law provides for the State Treasurer to issue debentures to the holders of the defaulted loan or bond which are payable on a parity with State general obligation bonds. All claims on insured loans to date have

 

D-21


Table of Contents
 

been paid from the Fund. For the fiscal year ending June 30, 2009, OSHPD insured approximately 134 loans to nonprofit or publicly owned health facilities throughout California for approximately $1.7 billion. As of that date, the cash balance of the Fund was approximately $192.6 million. The OSHPD reported to the California Legislature that, as of June 30, 2009, the Fund balance was $95.0 million (unaudited). The Fund balance is determined by taking the cash balance, adding the value of assets (obligations due to the OSHPD for defaulted projects) and subtracting the liabilities (obligations of the OSHPD for defaulted projects). The OSHPD engaged Oliver Wyman to perform the 2008 actuarial study of the Fund, which concluded, among other things, that it appeared to be sufficient, assuming “normal and expected” conditions, to maintain a positive balance over 30 years. Even assuming abnormal and unexpected events, the study found that the Fund’s reserves would protect against General Fund losses for 14 years. More information on the program can be obtained from OSHPD’s website.

Sources of Tax Revenues.

In fiscal year 2008-09, approximately 90% of the State’s General Fund revenues and transfers were derived from personal income taxes, corporation taxes, and sales and use taxes. The following are brief summaries of the major sources of tax revenues in the State. The sections below captioned “Sales and Use Tax” and “Corporation Tax” include descriptions of pending lawsuits relating to various taxes.

Personal Income Tax. The California personal income tax, which accounted for 52.4% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2008-09, is closely modeled after the federal income tax law. It is imposed on net taxable income (gross income less exclusions and deductions), with rates ranging from 1% to 9.3%. For tax years 2009 and 2010, the rates will range from 1.25% to 9.55%. The personal income tax is adjusted annually by the change in the consumer price index to prevent taxpayers from being pushed into higher tax brackets without a real increase in income. Personal, dependent, and other credits are allowed against the gross tax liability. In addition, taxpayers may be subject to an alternative minimum tax (“AMT”), which is much like the federal AMT. The personal income tax structure is considered to be highly progressive. For example, the Franchise Tax Board indicates that the top 1% of taxpayers paid 43% of the total personal income tax in tax year 2008.

Proposition 63, approved by the voters in the November 2004 election, imposes a 1% surcharge on taxable income over $1 million in addition to the 9.3% rate (9.55% for tax years 2009 and 2010). The surcharge became effective January 1, 2005. The proceeds of the tax surcharge are required to be used to expand mental health programs.

Taxes on capital gains realizations, which are largely linked to stock market performance, can add a significant dimension of volatility to personal income tax receipts. Capital gains tax receipts accounted for 14.8% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2000-01. The 2010-11 May Revision projected that capital gains would account for 3.6% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2009-10 and 5.8% in fiscal year 2010-11.

Sales and Use Tax. The sales and use tax (referred to herein as the “sales tax”), which accounted for 28.7% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2008-09, is imposed upon retailers for the privilege of selling tangible personal property in California. Most retail sales and leases are subject to the tax. However, exemptions have been provided for certain essentials such as food for home consumption, prescription drugs, gas delivered through mains, and electricity. Other exemptions provide relief for a variety of sales ranging from custom computer software to aircraft.

The California use tax is imposed at the same rates as the regular sales tax on consumers of tangible personal property that is used, consumed, or stored in this State. Use tax applies to purchases from out-of-state vendors that are not required to collect tax on their sales. Use tax also applies to most leases of tangible personal property.

 

D-22


Table of Contents

 

As of May 1, 2010, the breakdown of the base State and local sales tax rate of 8.25% was as follows:

 

   

6% imposed as a State General Fund tax (this tax rate is scheduled to return to 5% on July 1, 2011);

 

   

0.5% dedicated to local governments for health and welfare program realignment (Local Revenue Fund);

 

   

0.5% dedicated to local governments for public safety services (Local Public Safety Fund);

 

   

1% local tax imposed under the Uniform Local Sales and Use Tax Law, with 0.25% dedicated to county transportation purposes and 0.75% for city and county general-purpose use; and

 

   

0.25% deposited into the Fiscal Recovery Fund to repay the State’s ERBs (the “special sales tax”).

Existing law provides that 0.25% of the base State and local sales tax rate may be suspended in any calendar year upon certification by the Director of Finance, by November 1 in the prior year, that both of the following have occurred: (1) the General Fund reserve (excluding the revenues derived from the 0.25% special sales tax) is expected to exceed 3% of revenues in that fiscal year (excluding the revenues derived from the 0.25% special sales tax) and (2) actual revenues for the period May 1 through September 30 equal or exceed the previous May Revision forecast. The 0.25% rate will be reinstated the following year if the Director of Finance subsequently determines conditions (1) or (2) above are not met for that fiscal year. The Department of Finance estimates that the reserve level will be insufficient to trigger a reduction for calendar year 2010.

Existing law provides that the special sales tax will be collected until the first day of the calendar quarter at least 90 days after the Director of Finance certifies that all ERBs and related obligations have been paid or retired or provision for their repayment has been made or enough sales taxes have been collected to pay all ERBs and related obligations to final maturity. At such time the special sales tax will terminate and the city and county portion of taxes under the uniform local sales and use tax will be automatically increased by 0.25%.

Proposition 1A, approved by the voters in the November 2004 election, amended the State Constitution to, among other things, reduce the California Legislature’s authority over local government revenue sources by restricting the State from lowering the local sales tax rate or changing the allocation of local sales tax revenues without meeting certain conditions. A proposed initiative constitutional amendment would restrict the ability of the State to use or borrow money from local governments, and moneys dedicated to transportation financing. See “Recent Developments” above.

An appellate court decision from 2008 held that two Dell entities and two providers of maintenance and warranty services had improperly collected from customers and remitted to the BOE use tax on optional service contracts that were sold with computers. The State anticipates that a pending action will result in a judgment or settlement requiring the BOE to refund the tax with interest. Plaintiffs estimate that the refund amounts could be as much as $250 million. Identification and notification of consumers affected by the decision and thus due a refund is unresolved, and determination of the total refund amount depends upon such identification and notification. The 2010-11 May Revision projected that the refunds will not occur prior to fiscal year 2011-12.

Corporation Tax. The corporation tax accounted for 11.5% of General Fund revenues and transfers in fiscal year 2008-09. Corporation tax revenues are derived from the following taxes:

1. The franchise tax and the corporate income tax are levied at an 8.84% rate on profits. The former is imposed on corporations for the privilege of doing business in California, while the latter is imposed on corporations that derive income from California sources but are not sufficiently present to be classified as doing business in the State.

2. Banks and other financial corporations are subject to the franchise tax plus an additional tax at the rate of 2% on their net income. This additional tax is in lieu of personal property taxes and business license taxes.

3. The AMT is similar to that in federal law. In general, the AMT is based on a higher level of net income computed by adding back certain tax preferences. This tax is imposed at a rate of 6.65%.

 

D-23


Table of Contents

 

4. A minimum franchise tax of up to $800 is imposed on corporations subject to the franchise tax but not on those subject to the corporate income tax. New corporations are exempted from the minimum franchise tax for the first year of incorporation.

5. Sub-Chapter S corporations are taxed at 1.5% of profits.

6. Fees paid by limited liability companies (“LLCs”), which account for 2.8% of corporation tax revenue, are considered “corporation taxes.” Three separate cases have been filed challenging the constitutionality of the LLC fee. Two have been resolved and one is pending. In California Taxpayers Association v. Franchise Tax Board, California Taxpayers Association (“Cal-Tax”), plaintiffs challenged the constitutionality of the corporate understatement penalty that was enacted in Chapter 1, Statutes of 2007-08 First Extraordinary Session (SB X1 28, 2008 Budget Act Trailer Bill) and sought an injunction precluding the Franchise Tax Board from enforcing the statute. The trial court ruled for the State and Cal-Tax appealed. A decision may be issued during fiscal year 2010-11. An adverse ruling would resulting a potential loss or revenue in fiscal year 2010-11 of between $500 million and $800 million, and an ongoing loss of approximately $500 million thereafter.

As part of the 2009 Budget Act, the California Legislature adopted certain additional tax benefits for corporations, affecting carryover of losses, sharing tax credits among affiliates, and changes to the unitary tax calculations for multinational corporations, all of which were to become effective in 2011 or later. An initiative statute will be included on the November 2010 ballot that would repeal all of these new tax benefits. It is estimated that such a repeal, if approved by the voters, would increase General Fund revenues by approximately $1.7 billion annually starting in fiscal year 2011-12.

Insurance Tax. The majority of insurance written in California is subject to a 2.35% gross premium tax. For insurers, this premium tax takes the place of all other State and local taxes except those on real property and motor vehicles. Exceptions to the 2.35% rate are certain pension and profit-sharing plans which are taxed at the lesser rate of 0.5%, surplus lines and non-admitted insurance at 3% and ocean marine insurers at 5% of underwriting profits. To provide interim funding for the Healthy Families and Medi-Cal programs, Chapter 157, Statutes of 2009 extends the 2.35% gross premiums tax to the Medi-Cal managed care plans in 2009 and 2010.

The BOE ruled in December 2006 that the premium tax insurers pay should be calculated on a cash basis rather than the accrual method required by the California Department of Insurance. This ruling is expected to result in a total loss of $406 million spread over several years; the impact was $15 million in fiscal year 2008-09 and is estimated to be $11 million in fiscal year 2009-10, $230 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and $149 million in fiscal year 2011-12.

Vehicle License Fee. The Amended 2009 Budget Act temporarily increased the vehicle license fee from 0.65% to 1.15%, effective May 19, 2009, through June 30, 2011. Of this 0.5% increase, 0.35% goes to the General Fund, with the remaining 0.15% going to local law enforcement. An initiative has been qualified for the November 2010 ballot that would increase the annual vehicle license fee by $18 and dedicate the revenue to support of State parks and wildlife conservation. This measure, if approved by the voters, would generate an estimated $500 million per year for parks and wildlife conservation programs, which would save an equivalent amount of General Fund expenditures.

Estate Tax; Other Taxes. The State estate tax is based on the State death tax credit allowed against the federal estate tax. The California estate tax is designed to pick up the maximum credit allowed against the federal estate tax return. The federal Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act of 2001 (the “Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act”) phases out the federal estate tax by 2010. As a consequence, the Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act resulted in the reduction of the State estate tax revenues by 25% in calendar year 2002, 50% in calendar year 2003, and 75% in calendar year 2004, and the elimination of the State estate tax beginning in calendar year 2005. The provisions of this federal act sunset after 2010. At that time, the federal estate tax is scheduled to be reinstated along with the State’s estate tax. Federal estate tax law may be changed to modify or eliminate the State pick-up tax.

 

D-24


Table of Contents

 

Other General Fund major taxes and licenses include: Inheritance and Gift Taxes; Cigarette Taxes; Alcoholic Beverage Taxes; Horse Racing License Fees, and Trailer Coach License Fees.

Special Fund Revenues. The California Constitution and statutes specify the uses of certain revenues. Such receipts are accounted for in various special funds. In general, special fund revenues comprise three categories of income:

 

   

Receipts from tax levies which are allocated to specified functions, such as motor vehicle taxes and fees and certain taxes on tobacco products.

 

   

Charges for special services to specific functions, including such items as business and professional license fees.

 

   

Rental royalties and other receipts designated for particular purposes (e.g., oil and gas royalties).

Motor vehicle related taxes and fees are projected to account for 39% of all special fund revenues in fiscal year 2010-11. Principal sources of this income are motor vehicle fuel taxes, registration and weight fees, and vehicle license fees. In fiscal year 2010-11, $10.9 billion is projected to come from the ownership or operation of motor vehicles. Approximately $2.9 billion of this revenue is projected to be returned to local governments. The remainder will be available for various State programs related to transportation and services to vehicle owners.

Taxes on Tobacco Products. As a result of Proposition 99, approved by the voters in 1988, and Proposition 10, approved by the voters in 1998, the State imposes an excise tax on cigarettes of 87 cents per pack and the equivalent rates on other tobacco products. Tobacco product excise tax revenues are earmarked as follows:

1. Fifty cents of the per-pack tax on cigarettes and the equivalent rate levied on non-cigarette tobacco products are deposited in the California Children and Families First Trust Fund and are allocated primarily for early childhood development programs.

2. Twenty-five cents of the per-pack tax on cigarettes and the equivalent rates levied on non-cigarette tobacco products are allocated to the Cigarette and Tobacco Products Surtax Fund. These funds are appropriated for anti-tobacco education and research, indigent health services, and environmental and recreation programs.

3. Ten cents of the per-pack tax is allocated to the State’s General Fund.

4. The remaining two cents of the per-pack tax is deposited into the Breast Cancer Fund.

The following table shows the trend of major General Fund and total taxes per capita and per $100 of personal income for the past five fiscal years and fiscal year 2010-11.

Recent Tax Receipts

 

       State Taxes per Capita(a)        Taxes per $100
of Personal Income
 

Fiscal Year

     General Fund        Total        General Fund        Total  

2005-06

       2,451.75           2,867.55           6.52           7.63   

2006-07

       2,501.35           2,934.28           6.23           7.31   

2007-08

       2,530.79           2,967.26           6.06           7.11   

2008-09

       2,084.46           2,494.59           4.95           5.92   

2009-10

       2,189.84           2,571.00           5.40           6.34   

2010-11 (budget)

       2,265.68           2,701.14           5.46           6.51   

 

* Data reflects population figures based on the 2000 Census – estimated.

Source: State of California, Department of Finance.

 

D-25


Table of Contents

 

State Appropriations Limit.

The State is subject to an annual appropriations limit imposed by Article XIIIB of the State Constitution (the “Appropriations Limit”). The Appropriations Limit does not restrict appropriations to pay debt service on voter-authorized bonds.

Article XIII B prohibits the State from spending “appropriations subject to limitation” in excess of the Appropriations Limit. “Appropriations subject to limitation,” with respect to the State, are authorizations to spend “proceeds of taxes,” which consist of tax revenues, and certain other funds, including proceeds from regulatory licenses, user charges or other fees to the extent such proceeds exceed “the cost reasonably borne by that entity in providing the regulation, product or service,” but “proceeds of taxes” exclude most State subventions to local governments, tax refunds, and some benefit payments such as unemployment insurance. No limit is imposed on appropriations of funds which are not “proceeds of taxes,” such as reasonable user charges or fees and certain other non-tax funds.

There are various types of appropriations excluded from the Appropriations Limit. For example, debt service costs of bonds existing or authorized by January 1, 1979, or subsequently authorized by the voters, appropriations required to comply with mandates of courts or the federal government, appropriations for qualified capital outlay projects, appropriations for tax refunds, appropriations of revenues derived from any increase in gasoline taxes and motor vehicle weight fees above January 1, 1990 levels, and appropriation of certain special taxes imposed by initiative (e.g., cigarette and tobacco taxes) are all excluded. The Appropriations Limit may also be exceeded in cases of emergency.

The Appropriations Limit in each year is based on the Appropriations Limit for the prior year, adjusted annually for changes in State per capita personal income and changes in population, and adjusted, when applicable, for any transfer of financial responsibility of providing services to or from another unit of government or any transfer of the financial source for the provisions of services from tax proceeds to non-tax proceeds. The measurement of change in population is a blended average of statewide overall population growth, and change in attendance at local school and community college (K-14) districts. The Appropriations Limit is tested over consecutive two-year periods. Any excess of the aggregate “proceeds of taxes” received over such two-year period above the combined Appropriations Limits for those two years, is divided equally between transfers to K-14 districts and refunds to taxpayers.

The California Legislature has enacted legislation to implement Article XIIIB which defines certain terms used in Article XIIIB and sets forth the methods for determining the Appropriations Limit. California Government Code Section 7912 requires an estimate of the Appropriations Limit to be included in the Governor’s Budget, and thereafter to be subject to the budget process and established in the Budget Act.

The following table shows the Appropriations Limit for fiscal years 2006-07 through 2010-11.

State Appropriations Limit

(Dollars in Millions)

 

     2006-07     2007-08     2008-09     2009-10     2010-11  

State Appropriations Limit

   $ 72,307      $ 76,093      $ 79,858      $ 80,984      $ 79,118   

Appropriations Subject to Limit

     (58,663     (59,201     (48,233     (57,849 )*      (58,424 )* 
                                        

Amount (Over)/Under Limit

   $ 13,641      $ 16,892      $ 31,625      $ 23,135   $ 20,694

 

* Estimated/projected.

Source: State of California, Department of Finance.

 

D-26


Table of Contents

 

Litigation.

The State is continually a party to numerous legal proceedings, many of which could have an adverse impact on the State’s financial condition. Pending litigation currently includes, but is not limited to, cases involving issues related to the budget, taxes, environmental matters, health care, tribal gaming, transportation, education, and the State’s prison system, all of which, if decided adversely to California, could result in significant General Fund expenditures or otherwise impact the ability of the State to raise revenues.

Local Governments.

The primary units of local government in California are the 58 counties, which range in population from approximately 1,100 in Alpine County to approximately 10.4 million in Los Angeles County. Counties are responsible for the provision of many basic services, including indigent health care, welfare, jails, and public safety in unincorporated areas. There are also 480 incorporated cities in California and thousands of special districts formed for education, utilities, and other services.

The fiscal condition of local governments was changed when Proposition 13, which added Article XIIIA to the State Constitution, was approved by California voters in 1978. Proposition 13 reduced and limited the future growth of property taxes and limited the ability of local governments to impose “special taxes” (those devoted to a specific purpose) without two-thirds voter approval. Although Proposition 13 limited property tax growth rates, it also has had a smoothing effect on property tax revenues, ensuring greater stability in annual revenues than existed before Proposition 13 passed.

Proposition 218, another constitutional amendment enacted by initiative in 1996, further limited the ability of local governments to raise taxes, fees, and other exactions. (The limitations include requiring a majority vote approval for general local tax increases, prohibiting fees for services in excess of the cost of providing such service, and providing that no fee may be charged for fire, police, or any other service widely available to the public.)

In the aftermath of Proposition 13, the State provided aid to local governments from the General Fund to make up some of the loss of property tax moneys, including assuming principal responsibility for funding K-12 schools and community colleges. During the recession of the early 1990s, the California Legislature reduced the post-Proposition 13 aid to local government entities other than K-12 schools and community colleges by requiring cities and counties to transfer some of their property tax revenues to school districts. However, the California Legislature also provided additional funding sources, such as sales taxes, and reduced certain mandates for local services funded by cities and counties.

The 2004 Budget Act, related legislation, and the enactment of Proposition 1A in 2004 dramatically changed the State-local fiscal relationship. These constitutional and statutory changes implemented an agreement negotiated between the Governor and local government officials (the “state-local agreement”) in connection with the 2004 Budget Act. One change relates to the reduction of the vehicle license fee (“VLF”) rate from 2% to 0.65% of the market value of the vehicle. In order to protect local governments, which had previously received all VLF revenues, the 1.35% reduction in VLF revenue to cities and counties from this rate change was backfilled (or offset) by an increase in the amount of property tax revenues they receive. This worked to the benefit of local governments because the backfill amount annually increases in proportion to the growth in property tax revenues, which has historically grown at a higher rate than VLF revenues, although property tax revenues have declined over the past two years. This arrangement continues without change in the 2010-11 Governor’s Budget.

Pursuant to statutory changes made in conjunction with the Initial 2009 Budget Act, the VLF rate increased from 0.65% to 1.15% effective May 19, 2009. Of this 0.50% increase, 0.35% flows to the General Fund, and 0.15% supports various law enforcement programs previously funded by the General Fund. This increased VLF rate will be effective through the 2010-11 fiscal year.

 

D-27


Table of Contents

 

As part of the state-local agreement, voters at the November 2004 election approved Proposition 1A. Proposition 1A amended the State Constitution to, among other things, reduce the California Legislature’s authority over local government revenue sources by placing restrictions on the State’s access to local governments’ property, sales, and VLF revenues as of November 3, 2004.

The Amended 2009 Budget Act authorized the State to exercise its authority under Proposition 1A to borrow an amount equal to approximately 8% of local property tax revenues, or $1.9 billion, which must be repaid within three years. State law was also enacted to create a securitization mechanism for local governments to sell their right to receive the State’s payment obligations to a local government-operated joint powers authority. This joint powers authority sold bonds in a principal amount of $1.895 billion in November 2009 to pay the participating local governments their full property tax allocations when they normally would receive such allocations. Pursuant to Proposition 1A, the State is required to repay the local government borrowing (which in turn will be used to repay the bonds of the joint powers authority) no later than June 30, 2013. The 2010-11 Governor’s Budget includes $90.8 million for the interest payments that will be incurred in that fiscal year to be paid from the General Fund.

The Amended 2009 Budget Act also contained a shift of $1.7 billion in redevelopment agency funds from current revenue and reserves in fiscal year 2009-10 and $350 million in fiscal year 2010-11. These revenues are shifted to schools that serve the redevelopment areas. This frees an equal amount of base property tax that is shifted to the Supplemental Education Revenue Augmentation Funds in each county that are established by Proposition 1A and used for the same purposes. The enabling legislation allows redevelopment agencies to borrow from parent agencies, and from any available reserves in their low and moderate income housing funds.

The California Redevelopment Association (“CRA”), whose membership includes a large number of redevelopment agencies, has filed a lawsuit challenging the $1.7 billion shift described above. The 2008 Budget Act included a shift of $350 million of redevelopment agency moneys. The CRA had also challenged that shift, and a trial court held that the legislation providing for the shift was invalid, which prevented the State from shifting the funds for the 2008-09 fiscal year. The State withdrew its appeal of the decision and subsequently enacted legislation that addresses the concerns noted by the trial court. However, the subsequently enacted legislation is being challenged in the current CRA lawsuit. A group of counties has filed a separate lawsuit challenging the shift. The Sacramento County Superior Court issued a ruling on May 4, 2010, upholding the State’s ability to shift $1.7 billion and $350 million from redevelopment agencies in fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11, respectively. The CRA has appealed the ruling.

Economic, Political, Social and Environmental Conditions.

Changes in economic, political, social or environmental conditions on a local, State, federal and/or international level may adversely affect California’s financial condition, as well as investment risk generally. Such conditional changes may include (but are not limited to) fluctuations in business production, consumer prices or financial markets, unemployment rates, technological advancements, shortages or surpluses in natural resources or energy supplies, changes in law, social unrest, fluctuations in the crime rate, political conflict, acts of war or terrorism, environmental damage and natural disasters.

Georgia

Located in the southeastern region of the United States, the State of Georgia (“Georgia” and the “State”) has experienced substantial growth over the last several decades. Since 1960, the population of Georgia has more than doubled, currently making Georgia the country’s ninth most populated state. Between 2000 and 2009, Georgia grew by an estimated 1,642,758 people, a growth rate of 20.1 percent, fourth fastest in the nation, and fastest east of the Mississippi River (2009 Census estimate: 9,829,211). From 2000 to 2009, 17 of Georgia’s counties ranked among the nation’s 100 fastest-growing, second most in the nation, including two counties (both located in metro Atlanta) which ranked among the top ten.

 

D-28


Table of Contents

 

This population increase is expected to continue for the foreseeable future at approximately the same accelerated rate. In its March 2010 report, the Governor’s Office of Planning and Budget estimated that Georgia’s population will increase by an additional 4.6 million people over the next 20 years, with over 60% of this growth attributable to people moving into the state. While the fastest-paced growth is expected in the northern and coastal areas of the state, it is expected that the Atlanta MSA will remain the most densely populated area, with approximately 43% of all Georgians living in this area.

Georgia’s economy is fairly diversified, with private sector employment almost equally spread between manufacturing, services, wholesale sales and retail sales, with concentrations in manufacturing, trade, transportation and utilities, information technology, and professional and business services. During the second half of the 20th century, this diversity allowed Georgia to experience almost continuous economic growth, while other states more dependent upon a single business sector experienced some periods of economic contraction. However, during the last several years, this diversity has been unable to fully insulate Georgia’s economy from the nationwide economic downturn that occurred in 2002-2004 and the current one which began in December 2007.

One area where this economic diversity, in combination with Georgia’s population growth, and its effects on the local economy can be seen is Georgia’s labor market. Historically, Georgia has enjoyed an unemployment rate significantly at or below the national average. Unfortunately, as of June 2010, the state’s unemployment rate stood at 10.0%, which is slightly above the national average of 9.5%.

While the raw numbers are not positive, the trend is favorable. The Georgia unemployment rate is down from a high of 10.5% in March 2010 (but still above a year earlier rate of 9.7%). Similarly, the Georgia total non-farm employment figures are up (3.83 million for June 2010 as opposed to a low of 3.78 million in February 2010), but they are still below year earlier figures (3.88 million). This trend is reflected in the May 2010 US Regional Recession Status by Moody’s Economy.com which classifies Georgia to be “moderating recession,” defined as the state’s economy not contracting as severely as six months earlier.

Historically, most of the job growth in Georgia has been in the Atlanta MSA. However, over the last several years, there has been great emphasis placed upon developing other parts of the State, so that these areas can begin to reap the economic benefits traditionally limited to the Atlanta MSA. One example of this is the OneGeorgia Authority, which is discussed below. Those efforts have begun to bear fruit, as for the last several years, the statewide growth rate has exceeded the Atlanta MSA growth rate. However, this trend has been muted over the past year, as the rate of job loss in the Atlanta MSA (1.0%) has been slightly lower than the rate for the balance of the state (1.3%).

One reason that Georgia has such a positive economic outlook is because of its location, which affords its residents and businesses easy access to commercial centers throughout the nation and the world. As business and consumer confidence grows, it is believed that centers of transportation and logistics will gain as inventories get restocked and goods are shipped. Evidence of this upswing has been observed at both Hartsfield-Jackson Airport and the Port of Savannah; while cargo traffic still remains below prior year levels, as discussed below both locations have Georgia experienced an uptick in cargo traffic over the last few months.

For ground transportation, the capital city of Atlanta is one of the few major US cities with 3 interstate highways. As a result, Georgia manufacturers and distributors are within 2 truckload days of 82% of the US industrial market. During an average week, about 5.9 million tons of freight move across Georgia’s highways. Furthermore, Georgia has the most extensive rail system and largest intermodal hub in the Southeast. Georgia also ranks as the 5th largest overall logistics employer in the nation with nearly 11,000 providers of logistics services.

Since 1998, Hartsfield-Jackson (the “Airport”) has been the busiest passenger airport in the world, serving over 88,032,086 passengers in 2009 through 32 carriers, with destinations to over 231 destinations in 52

 

D-29


Table of Contents

countries. Also, for the fifth consecutive year, the Airport retains its title as the nation’s busiest airport in terms of operations (takeoffs and landings) with 970,258 operations. Atlanta is within a two hour flight of 80% of the United States population. The current economic downturn has negatively impacted the Airport. In 2009 the number of domestic travelers fell 1.69% in one year, while international passengers fell by 3.79%. This downward trend is expected to be short-lived, as annual Airport passenger traffic is anticipated to increase to 121,000,000 by 2015.

The Airport is also considered to be the best among air cargo facilities. In 2009, the Airport was named Air Cargo Week’s Airport of the Year, becoming the first U.S. airport to earn the top prize among the annual World Air Cargo Awards. The Airport also has over 2,000,000 square feet of cargo warehouse space and is the 11th largest air cargo hub in the country and 30th worldwide. In addition to the main cargo complexes, the Airport houses a USDA approved Perishables Complex, the only one in the Southeastern U.S. The Perishables Complex features on-site distribution and transport capabilities, USDA inspection services and a USDA approved fumigation chamber. The Airport is also the only airport in the Southeast to be approved by the USDA to apply cold treatment, which is an environmentally safe alternative to methyl bromide.

This infrastructure enabled the Airport to handle more than 563,139 metric tons of cargo in 2009 (a decrease of 14.06% from 2008); international cargo also decreased from 365,351 to 312,033 metric tons in 2009. However, since November 2009, the Airport has posted upswings in year-over-year cargo traffic for six consecutive months. Cargo traffic in April 2010 was 23.44% higher than the previous year. This figure is expected to grow as Asiana Airline announced it will join the Airport’s growing list of all-cargo carriers starting September 13, 2010. Asiana Airline will operate a freighter with four weekly flights to Seoul, South Korea. The new service is expected to create up to 25 jobs and produce an annual regional economic impact of $24 million.

To facilitate the projected increase in usage, the Airport is in the tenth year of a multi-year improvement project, which is the largest public works project in the history of the State of Georgia. The program was originally budgeted to cost $5.4 billion and to take 10 years to complete, but due to cost and time overruns, the project is now expected to be complete in 2015 at an estimated cost in excess of $6 billion. The centerpiece of this expansion is the building of a fifth runway, which opened on May 16, 2006 and has helped to reduce air traffic congestion by increasing the Airport’s landings and take-offs capacity by 40%. Another major piece of the expansion is the construction of a new international terminal which broke ground in the summer of 2008 and is set for completion in April 2012. The 1.2 million-square-foot international terminal will have 12 new international gates (plus 16 domestic gates) and a 1,100-space parking facility.

The success of the Airport has also had a tremendous impact on the local economy. A recent study commissioned by the City of Atlanta’s Department of Aviation calculated total direct business revenue, including sales to airlines and service providers dependent on the Airport, to be $32.6 billion in 2009, up from $23.5 billion in 2005. In addition, Airport-related jobs in the metro region increased by 11 percent, from 393,100 in 2005 to 434,400 in 2009. The Airport jobs paid more than $4.3 billion in wages in 2009 and generated more than $3 billion in tax revenues for the government.

Finally, with respect to water transport, Georgia has two significant deepwater ports, Savannah and Brunswick, as well as two inland barge operations, Columbus and Bainbridge. Like the Airport, these ports experienced a dip in traffic for 2009, but have recently begun to see a significant uptick in activity. Out of 361 ports in the U.S., Savannah is now the fourth largest container port in the country. It is also the fastest growing container port in the U.S., while the Port of Brunswick is the 6th-largest automobile processing port in the nation. In 2008, the Port of Savannah’s total exports exceeded one million TEUs for the first time in Georgia Ports Authority’s history. However, due to the economic slowdown, Savannah’s total trade declined almost 10% in 2009 over 2008. However, similar to the airport cargo traffic, Savannah has posted upswings in year-over-year TEU throughput for six consecutive months as the May TEU total was 24.7 percent higher than the previous year.

 

D-30


Table of Contents

 

Also like the Airport, Georgia’s water ports are currently involved in significant capital improvement projects. The Brunswick Deepening Project was completed in 2007 (deepening the mean water depth to 36 feet), as was the preliminary work for the Savannah Harbor Expansion Project. The latter project is expected to be complete by 2012 (2 years prior to the Panama Canal expansion) and will deepen Savannah Harbor from 42 feet to 48 feet. The expansion of the Panama Canal and the Savannah Harbor will allow much larger container ships, twice the capacity of current vessels, to access the Savannah port.

These factors have all contributed to Georgia’s significant link to the global economy, which is recognized by the over 60 countries that have consular, trade, or chamber of commerce offices in Atlanta. More than 4000 internationally-owned facilities representing over 60 countries are located in Georgia. In 2009, $23.8 billion in exports and $53 billion in imports passed through the ports, making Georgia the 12th-largest export state and 9th-largest import state in the U.S.

Over the last several years, Georgia has been successful in attracting international business. In February 2010, Kia Motor Co. (“Kia”), a South Korean automaker, celebrated the grand opening of Kia’s first North American manufacturing facility, located in West Point, Troup County, Georgia, which is located off Interstate 85 near the Georgia-Alabama border. The $1.2 billion facility will produce 300,000 cars a year. Also, seven supplier companies have located near the facility and are expected to employ approximately 3,600 workers. The Kia plant’s economic impact to Georgia is expected to be approximately $4 billion per year. One study predicts the economic benefits brought about by the Kia plant will create 20,000 new jobs by 2012.

In May 2010, Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications announced that it will locate the company’s new Americas headquarters in Atlanta, creating about 180 jobs. A few days before Sony Ericsson’s announcement, MAGE SOLAR GMBH, a Ravensburg, Germany-based manufacturer of solar energy products, also announced that it will locate its North American headquarters in Dublin, Georgia. MAGE SOLAR markets high-grade photovoltaic modules, high-performance branded inverters, and mounting systems used in the solar energy industry. This project is estimated to bring $30 million in investment and is estimated to create 350 jobs over five years.

To help foster this international business growth, the Georgia Department of Economic Development has instituted the “Global Georgia” program to promote Georgia within the international community and prioritize international business development. The Georgia Department of Economic Development currently has 10 offices located in Brazil, Canada, Chile, China, Europe (Munich, Germany), Japan, Korea, Mexico, Israel and UK & Ireland.

This pro business climate continues to be widely recognized. Recently, Georgia has been ranked among the top 10 states in which to do business by CNBC (#10), Forbes magazine (#6), and Pollina Corporate Real Estate (#8). In 2010, Chief Executive magazine selected Georgia as 7th best state for job growth and business. This is one of many reasons why Georgia is the home to 14 Fortune 500 companies (with the City of Atlanta having the fourth largest concentration of Fortune 500 companies in the United States), including AFLAC, The Coca-Cola Company, The Home Depot, UPS, Delta Air Lines, Newell Rubbermaid, and NCR. Overall, over 75% of the Fortune 1000 companies have a presence in the Atlanta metropolitan area.

As mentioned above, historically much of this economic largesse has centered around the capital city of Atlanta. However, recently the State government has taken several steps to ensure that the other areas of Georgia share in this growth. Of particular note is the OneGeorgia Authority (the “Authority”). Established in 2000 and funded with a portion of the State’s recovery in the nationwide tobacco litigation settlement, the Authority was created to provide financial assistance to development projects targeted to assist Georgia’s economically distressed areas. It is anticipated that the Authority will invest over $1.6 billion over the term of the tobacco settlement. Unfortunately, due to the economic downturn, the fund for OneGeorgia Authority’s rural economic development program was cut from the fiscal year (“FY”) 2010 budget. However, under the FY 2011 budget, Georgia expects to provide $47,123,333 to fund the rural economic development program.

 

D-31


Table of Contents

 

The State government of Georgia and its elected officials have historically adopted a very conservative fiscal approach. This approach has resulted in the State having one of the lowest debt levels, per capita, in the United States. In 2007, Georgia had the 3rd lowest state per-capita debt and 4th lowest instate debt as a percent of personal income. As a result, Georgia is one of seven states to maintain a triple “A” bond rating by all three major rating agencies (see below).

General obligation bonds are typically issued by the State pursuant to Article VII, Section IV of the Constitution of the State of Georgia (the “Georgia Constitution”), which provides that such bonds are the direct and general obligations of the State. The operative language is set forth in Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph VI of the Georgia Constitution which provides:

“The full faith, credit and taxing power of the State are hereby pledged to the payment of all public debt incurred under this article and all such debt and the interest on the debt shall be exempt from taxation (emphasis added). . .”.

The Georgia Constitution further obligates the Georgia General Assembly to “raise by taxation and appropriate each fiscal year . such amounts as are necessary to pay debt service requirements in such fiscal year on all general obligation debt.” The Georgia Constitution also establishes a special trust fund (the “State of Georgia General Obligation Debt Sinking Fund”), which is used for the payment of debt service requirements on all general obligation debt.

The Georgia Constitution also establishes certain limitations upon the amount of debt that the State can incur. In particular, Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph II(b) of the Georgia Constitution provides that, except in certain emergency situations (i.e., in times of war or to cover a temporary budget shortfall) the State may not incur additional debt if, in that fiscal year or any subsequent year, the cumulative annual debt service for both general obligation debt and guaranteed revenue debt (including the proposed debt) will exceed 10% of the total revenue receipts, less refunds, for the prior fiscal year. The Georgia Constitution prevents State departments and agencies from circumventing these debt limitation provisions by prohibiting them from executing contracts that may be deemed to constitute a security for bonds or other public obligations. (See Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph IV of the Georgia Constitution.)

As mentioned above, the State may incur “public debt to supply a temporary deficit in the State treasury in any fiscal year created by a delay in collecting the taxes of that year. Such debt shall not exceed, in the aggregate, 5% of the total revenue receipts, less refunds, of the State treasury in the fiscal year immediately preceding the year in which such debt is incurred.” (See Georgia Constitution, Article VII, Section IV, Paragraph I(b).) However, since this provision was enacted, the State has never had to exercise this power.

Virtually all debt obligations represented by bonds issued by the State of Georgia, counties or municipalities or other public subdivisions, and public authorities require validation by a judicial proceeding prior to the issuance of such obligation. The judicial validation makes these obligations incontestable and conclusive, as provided under the Georgia Constitution. (See Article VII, Section VI, Paragraph VI of the Georgia Constitution).

As of June 30, 2009, the State had total outstanding bonded debt of $10,771,468,000. While this represented a substantial increase over the prior year ($9,545,352,000), the State remained well below the 10% threshold at 5.4%. As a result, as of June 30, 2010, the State maintained credits ratings of Aaa, AAA, and AAA from Moody’s Investor Services, Fitch, Inc., and Standard and Poor’s, respectively, making it only one of seven states to maintain such status.

The State of Georgia operates on a fiscal year beginning on July 1 and ending on June 30. Each year the State Economist, the Governor and the State Revenue Commissioner jointly prepare a revenue forecast upon which is based the State budget which is considered, amended, and approved by the Georgia General Assembly.

 

D-32


Table of Contents

 

To protect the State in the event of a decline in State revenues, and reflective of its conservative fiscal approach, in 1976 the Georgia General Assembly established the Revenue Shortfall Reserve. This reserve is funded by surplus revenue collections, and its existence was instrumental in helping the State weather the nationwide economic downturn during FY 2002-FY 2004. During those 3 years, the State was able to cover revenue shortfalls by drawing monies from this reserve (approximately $680 million over the 3 year period) rather than raising taxes or cutting vital services. With the end of the economic downturn in FY 2005, the State then began to replenish the reserve, so that at the end of FY 2007, the reserve reached its peak with a balance of $1.7 billion (exceeding the pre-FY 2002 balance). Unfortunately, due to the economic downturn, this upward trend was reversed in FY 2008 and by the end of FY 2009 the Revenue Shortfall Reserve balance was reduced to $271 million.

This reserve increase was previously funded by the State experiencing substantial increases in revenue collections. For FY 2007, Georgia experienced a 7.5% increase over prior year collections ($17,600,126,000 versus $16,366,132,000). However, starting in the latter half of FY 2008, net revenue collections have declined. In FY 2009, total revenue collections were down by $1,830,818,000 (down 10.5%) from FY 2008 levels. The effect in the various subareas showed an overall decrease, as Individual Income Taxes (down 12.2%), Motor Fuel Taxes (down 14.8%), Corporate Income Taxes (down 26.3%) and Sales and Use Taxes (down 7.6%) were down from FY 2008 levels. The only areas in which the State experienced an increase in revenue collection were Property Taxes (up 1.9%) and Alcohol Beverages Tax (up 1.2%).

Unfortunately, this downward trend continued in FY 2010. Net revenue collections were down from FY 2009 in all areas, including Individual Income Taxes (down 10%), Motor Fuel Taxes (down 3.8%), Corporate Income Taxes (down 1.4%) and Sales and Use Taxes (down 10.6%). Overall, for FY 2010, net revenue collections totaled around $14 billion, down 9.1% from FY 2009.

On June 8, 2010, Governor Sonny Perdue signed the state’s $17.9 billion FY 2011 budget, $700 million less than the original FY 2010 budget. This budget was also $300 million less than the budget originally recommended to the legislature and $3.5 billion less than the original FY 2008 budget recommendation.

One continued positive source of revenue for the State has been the Georgia Lottery Corporation. Established in 1992, the State uses profits from the lottery to fund numerous education-based initiatives, including a voluntary, state-wide pre-Kindergarten education program and the HOPE Scholarship Program (for post-secondary education). In FY 2010, Georgia Lottery transferred $883,878,000 to the State Treasury’s Lottery for Education Account, over $11.7 million more than in FY 2009. The Georgia Lottery Corp. ended FY 2010 as the only traditional U.S. lottery to experience 12 consecutive years of growth in profits.

One significant byproduct of the HOPE Scholarship Program has been the substantial increase in the percentage of college educated adults. In 1999, only 21% of Georgia’s population had a college degree, far below the national average. In 2008, 27% of the population had a college degree, on par with the national average. Furthermore, in 2010, CNBC ranked the Georgia’s workforce number 3 in the nation.

Another positive source of income to the State has been the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (“ARRA”). During FY 2009, the State recognized $725 million in ARRA funds which were used for miscellaneous purposes.

Personal income is a second key indicator of economic conditions in Georgia. Total personal income, relative to that of the U.S., has been growing despite the economic downturn. For FY 2008, Georgia’s personal income grew by 4.9%, compared to 5.3% for the nation as a whole. However, in 2009 state personal income declined by an average of 1.7%, matching the national average.

Georgia has also undergone significant political change during the 21st century. In November 2002, the State elected its first Republican Governor since Reconstruction. In addition, in light of significant election gains, as

 

D-33


Table of Contents

well as the well-publicized switch of political parties by several State Senators, the Republican Party gained control of the State Senate. This trend continued in 2004, as the Republican Party gained control of the State House and a second Republican Senator was elected (making it the first time since Reconstruction that Georgia had 2 Republican Senators). There is uncertainty surrounding the upcoming 2010 elections as, in addition to voting on the Legislature, Georgians will elect a new Governor (the current Governor is prohibited from running due to a 2-term limit).

Significant Contingent Liabilities

In response to a written request from the State Auditor, the Law Department for the State identified the following material litigation, claims and assessments as of June 30, 2009:

Plymel, et al. v. Teachers Retirement System, et al., Fulton Superior Court Civil Action No. 2004-CV-84312; Georgia Supreme Court decision reported at 282 Ga. 409 (2006). The Plaintiffs in this case filed a class action in April, 2004, seeking additional retirement benefits retroactive to the time of their individual retirement dates for a class of those retirees who elected survivorship options and who retired between 1983 and February 1, 2003, in the retirement plan administered by the Teachers Retirement System of Georgia (“TRS”). Plaintiff/Retirees alleged that TRS’ failure to use updated mortality tables resulted in miscalculations of monthly benefits and therefore additional monies are due to Plaintiffs for underpayment of benefits. The Plaintiff class numbers approximately 15,000. TRS was unsuccessful defending the case on the merits. The court in Plymel utilized a statute of limitations of six years, a pre-judgment rate of interest of 7% and a post-judgment interest rate equal to prime plus 3%. The Plaintiffs’ attorneys were awarded a fee equal to 25% of the total liability due to the class under the judgment. The total liability for TRS in this case for the adjusted benefit payments and attorneys’ fees was finalized at $414,259,402 and, following a final payment in September, 2009, is paid in full. All payments made by TRS pursuant to this class action were paid from the assets of TRS.

William A. Willis, et at. v. Employees’ Retirement System of Georgia, et al., Fulton Superior Court Civil Action No. 2007-CV-128923, filed January 31, 2007, set forth against Employees’ Retirement System of Georgia (“ERS”) exactly the same issues as were presented in Plymel v. TRS. The parties having agreed that the Plymel rulings will apply in Willis as well, ERS conceded liability on the breach of contract claim in Willis. ERS has agreed, and the Court has accepted, that the parties will use the statute of limitations and interest rate figures used in the Plymel case. The total liability for ERS in this case for the adjusted benefit payments and attorneys’ fees was finalized at $145,972,960. To date, ERS has made payments of approximately $31,309,000 in FY 2009, and approximately $43,500,000 on September 1, 2009, with approximately $71,164,000 liability outstanding and payable over time. All payments made by ERS pursuant to this class action are paid from the assets of ERS. The only remaining issue outstanding in Willis concerns application of an administrative rule that limits retirement benefits to 90% of the highest salary earned by the member while actively employed. This issue was scheduled to be heard before the court in September, 2009, but the hearing was postponed pending settlement discussions. A status conference was scheduled for January 21, 2010. The outcome of this issue is not anticipated to have an appreciable effect on the total liability amount.

Smitha Anderson v. PSERS, et al., Fulton Superior Court Civil Action No. 2008-CV-154757. This is another class action presenting the same issues as Willis and Plymel, set forth against the Public School Employees Retirement System (“PSERS”). The parties agreed to apply the same statute of imitations and interest rates determined in Willis and Plymel. The total liability for PSERS in this case for adjusted benefit payments and attorneys’ fees was finalized at $2,168,024. To date, PSERS has made payments of approximately $1,086,000, with approximately $1,082,000 liability outstanding and payable over time. All payments made by PSERS pursuant to this class action are paid from the assets of PSERS.

Georgia Power Company v. Graham, Fulton County Superior Court Civil Action File No. 2007-CV 137383 filed on or about July 24, 2007. This case arose from Georgia Power’s claim for the Port Tax Credit (the “Credit”) provided by O.C.G.A. § 48-7-40.15. Georgia Power asserts that its increase in imports through Georgia

 

D-34


Table of Contents

ports during the tax years 2002 through 2004 inclusive qualifies Georgia Power to receive a Credit based income tax refund. The total Credit claimed is in excess of $50 million, although the amount of refund for each taxable year is capped, with the excess Credit carrying forward to subsequent tax years. The Commissioner has answered the Complaint asserting that Georgia Power Company does not satisfy the statutory requirements to qualify for the Credit. Discovery in this case is complete and the parties have filed cross-motions for summary judgment. It is anticipated that oral argument on the cross-motions for summary judgment will be heard in January 2010.

Western Surety Company and Continental Casualty Company v. the State of Georgia, Department of Transportation, Heard County Superior Court Civil Action No. 08-v-l06. The plaintiff, Western Surety Company and Continental Casualty Company (“Western Surety”) was the surety company for Bruce Albea Company (“BAC”) on a Georgia Department of Transportation (“GDOT”) project. On June 29, 2007 BAC delivered a notice to GDOT advising that it was voluntarily abandoning the project. GDOT directed Western Surety to take over the work in accordance with the construction contract and Western Surety subsequently hired a completion contractor. Western Surety filed this action against GDOT on March 18, 2008, alleging three breach of contract causes of action, two related to price escalations of asphalt both prior to and subsequent to the original completion date, and the third alleging the failure to pay an outstanding contract balance in excess of $500,000 for work performed by the completion contractor. Western Surety also alleges a claim under the Prompt Payment Act. The case is currently in discovery. Plaintiffs have not stated a final claim amount but preliminary indications of potential damages sought are approximately $9,000,000.

Salary-Related Litigation: A state employee and certain teachers have brought separate law suits challenging steps the State has taken to manage expenditures relative to reduced revenues. In Stalling, et at. v. State of Georgia, et al., several school teachers contend that: (i) a statutory amendment making the payment of monetary incentives to teachers for achieving national certification “subject to appropriations” of funding for such incentive payments and (ii) any subsequent reductions in the appropriations are unconstitutional. In Estill, et al. v. State of Georgia, et al., a state employee seeks class certification and contends that state employees were entitled under state law to a general salary increase of 2 1/2% for the latter half of FY 2009 on the basis of initial appropriations (later reduced). Both cases are pending in the Superior Court of Fulton County and are in the initial stages of litigation. The State’s position is that the statute challenged in the Stalling case is constitutional; that the actions of the defendants in both cases were within their lawful authority, and that the plaintiffs in both cases are not entitled to any relief.

Citibank USA, N.A., et al. v. Bart L. Graham, Fulton County Superior Court, Case No.2007-CV-140161. This action was filed on September 20, 2007 and seeks a sales tax refund of $10,147,730 from the Department of Revenue. It involves a legal issue decided in the Department’s favor in Citibank USA, N.A., et al. v. Graham, Fulton County Superior Court, Case No. 2005-CV-109444, which was filed December 2, 2005 to obtain a $2,281,990 refund. Citibank’s application for discretionary appeal in the first lawsuit was denied by the Georgia Court of Appeals. The issues in second case are fully briefed, and we are awaiting a decision on the Department’s motion to dismiss.

Kenny A., et at. v. Sonny Perdue, Department of Human Resources, et al., United States Court of Appeals for the Eleventh Circuit, Nos. 06-15514, 06-15874. This was a class action lawsuit filed on behalf of 2,200 children in state custody asserting systemic deficiencies in foster care in Fulton and DeKalb counties. A Consent Decree was entered wherein the Department of Human Resources (“DHR”) agreed to make a number of specific system-wide management and infrastructure reforms. The District Court appointed two independent accountability agents to monitor DHR’s progress and awarded attorneys’ fees to the plaintiffs in the amount of $10.5 million. DHR appealed the award of attorneys’ fees to the Eleventh Circuit Court of Appeals. In July, 2008, the Court of Appeals affirmed the entire award. However, the majority opinion noted that the panel grudgingly affirmed the $4.5 million multiplier applied by the district court because they were bound by Eleventh Circuit precedent which may conflict with that of the United States Supreme Court. In light of the tone of the majority and concurring opinions, DHR filed a petition for rehearing en banc in the Eleventh Circuit which was denied on November 5, 2008. On April 6, 2009, the U.S. Supreme Court granted the State’s petition for

 

D-35


Table of Contents

certiorari on the award of attorney’s fees in this case, and oral argument was conducted before the Supreme Court on October 14, 2009. A decision in this case is not expected until mid-2010.

Buford Dam/Lake Lanier Water Litigation: The State is involved in multi-district litigation in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida which includes several cases involving the operation of Buford Dam and Lake Lanier. In 1946, the U.S. Congress authorized and funded the construction of the Buford Dam, and granted the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers (the “Corps”) authority to operate Buford Dam and the resulting reservoir, Lake Lanier. Water supply was declared to be an incidental purpose of the project. Construction on the dam commenced in 1950 and lasted approximately six years. In 1958, the U.S. Congress enacted the Water Supply Act of 1958, which allowed the Corps to use its reservoir projects for municipal water supply subject to certain restrictions. During the 1970’s the Corps began to enter into water supply contracts with certain Georgia municipalities allocating water from Lake Lanier storage for local water supply. The Corps took the position that this was an appropriate use. However, when Atlanta and other surrounding communities sought additional water in the late 1980’s, the Corps prepared a draft post authorization change report as part of the process of granting the request. Subsequently, Alabama initiated litigation against the Corps in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Alabama, in which Florida and Georgia intervened.

Following almost twenty years of litigation and negotiations involving the use of water among various private entities and governmental entities in Georgia, Alabama, and Florida, multiple cases involving the use of the waters of the Apalachicola-Chattahoochee-Flint River Basin were referred to the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida (the “District Court”), sitting as a multi-district litigation court, for resolution. The main components of such litigation are: (1) a case involving the rights of Georgia municipalities to use water from Lake Lanier (the “Georgia I” case); (2) a case involving the right of the Southeastern Federal Power Customers Association to be compensated for loss of hydroelectric power production due to the increasing use of water from Lake Lanier by Georgia municipalities; and (3) a case dealing with the quantity of water that the Corps should release from Lake Lanier to support the habitat of certain endangered species in the Apalachicola River in Florida in purported violation of the Endangered Species Act (the “ESA Litigation”). The ESA Litigation is in the early stages.

On July 17, 2009, the District Court issued an order making the following findings in the Georgia I case (the “Georgia I Order”): (1) water supply is not an authorized purpose of Lake Lanier, i.e., the lake was not built to provide for water supplies to municipalities in Georgia; (2) the quantity of water usage that would be authorized under a 1989 draft post authorization change in use report prepared by the Corps would require approval by the U.S. Congress; (3) the present level of water usage from Lake Lanier by Georgia municipalities violates the Federal Water Supply Act of 1958 and therefore is not authorized; and (4) the request by Georgia to the Corps, made in 2000, for additional water from Lake Lanier, would also violate the Federal Water Supply Act of 1958, and would be unauthorized. The Georgia I Order allows Georgia municipalities to continue using water from Lake Lanier for three years at current water usage levels in order to achieve a Congressional or other settlement, after which water usage from Lake Lanier (in the form of withdrawals from the lake and releases for downstream withdrawal) must revert to the “baseline” operation of the mid-1970’s, with an exception for withdrawal of 10 million gallons of water per day for the cities of Buford and Gainesville, Georgia. The State has filed a notice of appeal and has also requested that the District Court enter final judgment in Georgia I on the theory that all issues in such case are resolved. The District Court has declined the State’s request for the entry of final judgment. Alabama and Florida, as opposing parties, contend that the Georgia I Order is not appealable and have asked the Eleventh Circuit Court of Appeals to dismiss Georgia’s appeal.

Maryland

Risks of Concentration. The following information as to certain state specific considerations is given to investors in view of the Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund’s policy of concentrating its investments in Maryland issuers. This information supplements the information in the prospectus. This information constitutes only a brief summary, does not purport to be a complete description and is based on information from official

 

D-36


Table of Contents

statements relating to securities offerings of the State of Maryland (“Maryland” or the “State”) and other sources that are generally available to investors as of July 15, 2010. While generally believed to be accurate, we have not independently verified the information in this summary and will not be updating it during the year. Estimates and projections are based upon assumptions which could be affected by many factors and there can be no assurance that such estimates and projections will prove, or continue, to be accurate.

Unless stated otherwise, the ratings indicated are for obligations of the State and are current as of July 15, 2010; there can be no assurance that these ratings will not change. Bonds issued by Maryland’s political subdivisions and other issuers of tax-exempt bonds may have different ratings which are unrelated to the ratings assigned to State bonds. Similarly, conduit bonds issued for private borrowers have ratings which are unrelated to the ratings assigned to State bonds.

Maryland and its economy. According to the 2000 Census, Maryland’s population on April 1 of that year was 5,296,486, an increase of 10.8% from the 1990 Census. Maryland’s population is concentrated in urban areas. Approximately 87.0% of Maryland’s population lives in the densely populated Baltimore-Washington region. Per capita income in 2009 was $48,285 in Maryland, compared to the national average of $39,138 in that year. Per capita income in Maryland increased at an annual rate of 0.3% in 2009, higher than the national decline of 2.6%.

Maryland’s economy is more reliant on the service and government sectors than the nation as a whole, while the manufacturing sector is much less significant in Maryland than it is nationwide. As one of the wealthier states, in Maryland a greater share of personal income is derived from dividends, interest and rent, and a lesser share comes from transfer payments. Maryland’s economy is also particularly sensitive to changes in federal employment and spending. The percentage of personal income earned from federal and military employment in 2009 was 10.5% for Maryland residents, compared to 4.1% nationwide. Maryland’s unemployment rate has been lower than the rest of the country for the past ten years, while the labor force in Maryland has grown more slowly than the rest of the country in seven of the last ten years. In 2009, the unemployment rate in Maryland was 7.0%, as compared to a national unemployment rate of 9.3%. In May 2010 these rates had increased to 7.2% in Maryland and 9.7% in the United States as a result of the ongoing economic downturn.

State fiscal information. The Maryland Constitution requires the State to enact a balanced budget for each of its fiscal years, which run from July 1 to June 30. Maryland’s fiscal year 2009 ended with a $87.2 million general fund balance on a budgetary basis, reflecting a $349.9 million decrease compared to the balance projected at the time the fiscal year 2010 budget was enacted. In addition, there was a balance of $691.8 million in the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund. The Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund provides financial support for future needs of the State and is intended to reduce the need for future tax and other revenue increases. However, the State can move funds in the Revenue Stabilization Account to cover other areas of its budget, and has done so recently. As described below, over the last few years the State has used reserve funds to pay for operating shortfalls. General fund revenues on a budgetary basis realized in the State’s fiscal year 2009 were below estimates by $356.4 million, or 2.7%. On a GAAP basis, the fiscal year 2009 reserved general fund balance was $1,363.0 million, while the unreserved, designated and undesignated, fund balances were $146.9 million and $0.0 million, respectively; these balances compare to the reserved general fund balance of $1,388.2 million, and unreserved, designated and undesignated, fund balances of $538.0 million and $959.4 million, respectively, at the end of fiscal year 2008.

2010 budget. On April 13, 2009, the General Assembly approved the budget for fiscal year 2010. The fiscal year 2010 budget included, among other things: (1) funds to the State’s retirement and pension systems consistent with the “corridor” methodology of funding as prescribed by statute; (2) $5,736.3 million in aid to local governments from general funds reflecting full funding of the Thornton public school assistance program; and (3) deficiency appropriations of $273.0 million for fiscal year 2009, including a reduction of $364.9 million in the Department of Health and Mental Hygiene primarily in Medicaid due to the availability of federal stimulus funds as further described below.

 

D-37


Table of Contents

 

As part of the fiscal year 2010 budget plan, the General Assembly enacted the Budget Reconciliation and Financing Act of 2009 (the “2009 Act”), which provided for transfers to the General Fund in fiscal year 2010 of $216.3 million, including $31.0 million of transfer tax revenues and $161.9 million from the local share of highway user revenues. The 2009 Act and other legislative actions cumulatively decreased fiscal year 2010 revenues by $24.8 million.

Reductions to required fiscal year 2010 general fund appropriations included $34.0 million in aid to community colleges; $24.0 million due to modifications in the local jail reimbursement program; $16.1 million representing a decrease in the State share (from 80% to 70%) of the cost of placing students with special needs in non-public establishments; and $11.8 million reflecting the elimination of a State match of employee contributions to the deferred compensation plan. The fiscal year 2010 budget did not include funds for any employee cost of living adjustment or merit increases. State aid to primary and secondary schools included $10.8 million in Education Trust Fund revenues generated through anticipated licensing fees for Video Lottery Terminals and $297.3 million in State Fiscal Stabilization Funds authorized by the American Recovery and Reimbursement Act of 2009 (“ARRA”). The fiscal year 2010 budget also included $660.0 million in additional federal funds for the Medicaid program resulting from increased federal funding authorized by ARRA.

The fiscal year 2010 budget included $139.9 million for the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund. The required certain payment of $63.0 million from the Dedicated Purpose Account to the Maryland Transportation Authority for certain transportation projects was reduced and funded with general obligation bonds instead. Transfers from the State Reserve Fund to the general fund totaled $210.0 million in fiscal year 2010.

Subsequent Events – fiscal year 2010. In order to close emerging gaps between anticipated revenues and budgeted expenditures, the Governor proposed, and the Board of Public Works approved, general fund budget reductions of $205.3 million on July 22, 2009, $223.3 million on August 26, 2009 and $102.8 million on November 18, 2009.

As part of the fiscal year 2011 budget plan discussed below, the General Assembly enacted the Budget Reconciliation and Financing Act of 2010 (the “2010 Act”), legislation that authorizes various funding changes resulting in increased general fund revenues and decreased general fund appropriations. The 2010 Act authorized transfers to the general fund in fiscal year 2010 of $317.4 million from various special fund balances, including $136.2 million from a highway user revenue account and $133.3 million from the University System of Maryland. An additional $330.1 million in unexpended capital program balances were authorized for transfer to the general fund, including $103.1 million from the local jurisdictions’ share of certain park improvement funds. The 2010 Act and other legislative actions cumulatively increase fiscal year 2010 general fund revenues by $58.8 million. As of July 15, 2010, the State estimated that the general fund balance on a budgetary basis at June 30, 2010 would be $153.8 million. In addition, the State estimated that the balance in the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund would be $612.1 million at June 30, 2010, equal to 4.8% of estimated general fund revenues.

2011 Budget. On April 12, 2010, the General Assembly enacted the budget for fiscal year 2011. The fiscal year 2011 budget includes, among other things: (1) funds to the State’s retirement and pension systems consistent with the “corridor” methodology of funding as prescribed by statute; (2) $5,741.6 million in aid to local governments from general funds; (3) $15.0 million to the State Reserve Fund; and (4) deficiency appropriations of $195.8 million for fiscal year 2010, including $108.9 million for Medicaid and $39.3 million for public education. The fiscal year 2011 budget does not include funds for any employee cost of living adjustment, merit increases, nor a match for contributions to deferred compensation.

As part of the fiscal year 2011 budget plan, the General Assembly enacted the 2010 Act, which increases fiscal year 2011 general fund revenues by $35.5 million, including $22.1 million by diverting to the general fund a portion of sales taxes and motor fuel taxes from the Chesapeake Bay 2010 Fund, $11.0 million resulting from

 

D-38


Table of Contents

changes in the allocation of interest earnings that otherwise would be retained in special funds accounts, and $2.4 million in admissions and amusement tax attributable to the cultural arts. The fiscal year 2011 budget also includes net general fund revenue increases of $9.2 million from various sources. The 2010 Act authorizes transfers to the general fund in fiscal year 2011 of $22.3 million, including $11.7 million from the University System of Maryland and $6.0 million in furlough-related savings from various special funds. The 2010 Act also authorizes transfers to the general fund totaling $111.7 million from capital-related special fund balances, including $45.0 million from the Bay Restoration Fund and $54.0 million in transfer tax revenues.

State aid to primary and secondary schools includes $114.0 million in Education Trust Fund revenues generated through $60.0 million in anticipated revenue from Video Lottery Terminals and $54.0 million in gaming licensing fees. The 2011 budget also includes $389.0 million in additional federal funds for the Medicaid program. The State has indicated that it anticipates federal legislation extending the enhanced federal Medicaid match provisions originally authorized by ARRA; at this time, this legislation has not been enacted.

The fiscal year 2011 budget includes $15.0 million for the State Reserve Fund in the Dedicated Purpose Account for distribution to the Department of Health and Mental Hygiene for the Prince George’s County Health Care System. The fiscal year 2011 budget also eliminates operating funds for certain road improvements, which will be funded in fiscal year 2011 by general obligation bonds instead. No transfers from the State Reserve Fund to the general fund are planned in fiscal year 2011.

As of July 15, 2010, the State projected the general fund balance on a budgetary basis at June 30, 2011 to be $203.9 million. In addition, the State projected the balance in the Revenue Stabilization Account of the State Reserve Fund to be $630.7 million at June 30, 2011, equal to 4.8% of estimated general fund revenues.

Federal stimulus funding. ARRA provides support for the states, including the State, by funding infrastructure, education programs, human services programs, and providing discretionary funds. ARRA provides over $4.5 billion in formula funding to Maryland governments. ARRA grants to Maryland provide $421.7 million for educational programs, $765.2 million for infrastructure programs, and $477.7 million for other programs. ARRA also includes $101.8 million in grants to local governments and aid organizations that are not appropriated in the State budget. These funds will be distributed directly to the local governments and aid organizations.

ARRA also provides federal grants for which State and local governments must compete, including grants to support law enforcement, habitat conservation, and the arts. It is uncertain how much of these funds the State or Maryland local governments will receive and, accordingly, they are not included in ARRA estimates for Maryland.

ARRA’s most significant impact for Maryland is the $2.9 billion that can support State general fund commitments. These funds support Medicaid, education, and discretionary State spending; the funds are used in the place of general funds to sustain State funding from fiscal years 2009 to 2011. When the funds are no longer available, the State and other Maryland local government will need to replace the funds or reduce spending. ARRA also permits 18.2% of the Fiscal Stabilization funds to support general government services; these funds, which total $160.1 million, have been applied $1.5 million in fiscal year 2009, $79.6 million to 2010 and the remaining $79.0 million is included in the fiscal year 2011 budget.

Other fiscal challenges facing Maryland. The State also has a substantial unfunded actuarial liability, estimated to be approximately $18.4 billion as of June 30, 2009, or 172.2% of payroll, on the pension plans guaranteed by the State. Other retirement programs administered by the State also are experiencing material shortfalls, as are the retirement programs of the City of Baltimore. In addition, after several years of analysis of the State’s other post-employment benefit (“OPEB”) liabilities, the State has determined that the State’s unfunded actuarial accrued liability for OPEB liabilities was $15.5 billion as of June 30, 2009; the amount held in trust to pay OPEB liabilities was $174.3 million as of that date. A commission formed in 2006 to develop a

 

D-39


Table of Contents

plan with respect to the State’s OPEB liabilities reported in an Interim Report released in December 2008 that, in its view, Maryland cannot sustain the current level of retiree health benefits. The commission is continuing to explore options for redesigning retired health benefits and/or the way the State pays for them to arrive at a solution that is both fiscally sound and fair to current and retired State employees.

State-level municipal obligations. Neither the Constitution nor general laws of Maryland impose any limit on the amount of debt the State can incur. However, Maryland’s Constitution prohibits the creation of State debt unless it is authorized by a law that provides for the collection of an annual tax or taxes sufficient to pay the interest when due and to discharge the principal within 15 years of the date of issuance. Taxes levied for this purpose may not be repealed or applied to any other purpose until the debt is fully discharged. These restrictions do not necessarily apply to other issuers within the State. The General Assembly, by separate enabling act, typically authorizes a particular loan for a particular project or purpose. In its fiscal year 2009 capital program, 49% of the new general obligations bond authorizations represent financing of State-owned capital facilities and State programs, 50% represent financing of capital improvements owned by local governmental units, and 1% represent financing of capital improvements owned by non-profit or other private entities. The Board of Public Works authorizes State general obligation bond issues and supervises the expenditure of funds received therefrom, as well as all funds appropriated for capital improvements other than roads, bridges and highways. The State has projected to have approximately $9,695.1 billion of State tax-supported debt outstanding as of July 31, 2010.

The State’s public indebtedness can be generally divided into the following categories:

 

   

The State and various counties, agencies and municipalities of the State issue general obligation bonds, payable from ad valorem taxes, for capital improvements and for various projects, including local-government initiatives and grants to private, nonprofit, cultural and educational institutions. The State’s real property tax is pledged exclusively to the repayment of its bonds. The Board of Public Works is required to fix the property tax rate by each May 1 in an amount sufficient to pay all debt service on the State’s general obligation bonds for the coming fiscal year. At least since the end of the Civil War, Maryland has paid the principal of and interest on its general obligation bonds when due. As of July 15, 2010, the State’s general obligation bonds were rated AAA by Fitch, Aaa by Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., and AAA by Standard & Poor’s. We cannot assure you that such ratings will be maintained in the future.

 

   

The Maryland Department of Transportation issues limited special-obligation bonds for transportation purposes, payable primarily from specific, fixed-rate excise taxes and other revenues generated from the financed facilities, including an expansion to BWI airport, rail transportation facilities, highways and other transportation facilities. Holders of these bonds are not entitled to look to any other sources of payment. The 2009 General Assembly established a maximum outstanding principal amount of $661.8 million as of June 30, 2010, for all nontraditional debt of the Maryland Department of Transportation. Nontraditional debt outstanding is defined as any debt instrument that is not a consolidated transportation bond or Grant Anticipation Revenue Vehicle (“GARVEE”) Bond; such debt includes, but is not limited to, certificates of participation (documented by conditional purchase agreements), debt backed by customer facility charges, passenger facility charges, or other revenues, and debt issued by Maryland Economic Development Corporation (“MEDCO”) or any other third party on behalf of the Maryland Department of Transportation. As of March 31, 2010, the outstanding principal amount of such nontraditional debt was $671.4 million and is projected to be $661.8 million at June 30, 2010.

 

   

The Maryland Stadium Authority issues limited special-obligation bonds and notes to finance stadiums, convention centers and recreational facilities payable primarily from lease rentals, sports lottery and other revenues. At March 31, 2010, the principal amount of outstanding Maryland Stadium Authority bonds and capital leases was $249.7 million.

 

D-40


Table of Contents

 

   

Certain other State units, such as Maryland’s university systems, the Maryland Transportation Authority and the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration, as well as several local governments, are authorized to borrow funds pursuant to legislation that expressly provides that the State will not be deemed to have given any pledge or assurance of repayment, and for which the State will have no liability for repayment. These obligations are payable solely from specific non-tax revenues of the borrowers, including loan obligations from nonprofit organizations, corporations and other private entities. The issuers of these obligations are subject to various economic risks and uncertainties, and the credit quality of the securities issued by them may vary considerably from the quality of obligations backed by the full faith and credit of the State of Maryland. For example, the Maryland Transportation Authority, like the Maryland Department of Transportation, has issued bonds which are payable solely from collections from airline travel; declines in air traffic at BWI airport could impede repayment of such bonds.

 

   

During the 2004 General Session, the General Assembly created the Bay Restoration Fund to be managed by the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration. The Bay Restoration Fund receives a mandatory fee of $30 per year per equivalent dwelling unit from users of sewerage systems in Maryland, as well as $30 per year from septic system users. The Bay Restoration Fund sewer fee generated $53.3 million in revenue (cash basis) during fiscal year 2009. Future sewer fee revenues are projected at approximately $55.0 million per year. The sewer fee revenues are pledged, to the extent necessary, as security for revenue bonds issued by the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration, the proceeds of which will be applied primarily to provide grant funds to upgrade wastewater treatment plants with enhanced nutrient removal technology. The first $50 million of Bay Restoration Revenue Bonds were issued on June 25, 2008. Between 2010 and 2012, the Maryland Water Quality Financing Administration expects to issue an additional $480.0 million in Bay Restoration Revenue Bonds. A fiscal year 2010 transfer of $155.0 million and a fiscal year 2011 transfer of $45.0 million from the Bay Restoration Fund to the general fund will not affect the security or issuance of these bonds.

 

   

The State, its agencies and departments, and the various localities also enter into a variety of municipal leases, installment purchase, conditional purchase, sale-leaseback and similar transactions to finance the construction and acquisition of facilities and equipment. Such arrangements are not general obligations to which the issuing government’s taxing power is pledged but are ordinarily backed by the issuer’s covenant to budget for, appropriate and make the payments due on such obligations. Such arrangements generally contain “non-appropriation” clauses which provide that the issuing government has no obligation to make payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a yearly basis. In the event that appropriations are not made, the issuing government cannot be held contractually liable for the payments. As of June 30, 2010 the total of such financings outstanding was $210.6 million.

Although the State has the authority to make short-term borrowings up to a maximum of $100 million in anticipation of taxes and other receipts, in the past 20 years the State has not issued short-term tax anticipation notes or made any other similar short-term borrowings for cash flow purposes.

Other issuers of municipal bonds. Maryland can be divided into 24 subdivisions, comprised of 23 counties plus the independent City of Baltimore. Some of the counties and the City of Baltimore operate pursuant to the provisions of charters or codes of their own adoption, while others operate pursuant to State statutes. As a result, not all localities in Maryland follow the debt-authorization procedures outlined above. Maryland counties and the City of Baltimore typically receive most of their revenues from taxes on real and personal property, income taxes, miscellaneous taxes, and aid from the State. Their expenditures include public education, public safety, public works, health, public welfare, court and correctional services, and general governmental costs. Although some of these localities have received ratings of AAA from rating agencies, these ratings are often achieved through bond insurance or other credit enhancement. Over the last several years, however, repeated downgrades

 

D-41


Table of Contents

of the ratings of bond insurers have resulted in substantially lower ratings on these bonds. Additionally, most issuers within Maryland have received lower ratings than the State.

Many of Maryland’s counties have established subsidiary agencies with bond-issuing powers, such as sanitary districts, housing authorities, parking revenue authorities and industrial development authorities. For example, the Washington Suburban Sanitary Commission, which provides water and sewerage services in the District of Columbia area, and the Maryland-National Capital Park and Planning Commission, which administers a park system, both issue bonds. Many of the municipal corporations in Maryland have also issued bonds. In addition, all Maryland localities have the authority under State law to issue bonds payable from payments from private borrowers. All of these entities are subject to various economic risks and uncertainties, including the risks faced by the Maryland economy generally, and the credit quality of the securities issued by them varies with the financial strengths of the respective borrowers and the revenues pledged to the repayment of the bonds.

Local governments in Maryland receive substantial aid from the State for a variety of programs, including education costs and discretionary grants. However, cuts in State aid to local governments, lower tax and other receipts and the overall economic situation have required some Maryland counties and municipalities to find creative sources of revenue and to cut services and expenditures. The ongoing budget shortfalls at the State level, as well as other future events, might require further reductions in, or the discontinuation of, some or all State aid payments to local governments. Cutbacks in State aid and reductions in other local revenues are adversely affecting local economies.

Risks and uncertainties. Generally, the primary default risk associated with government obligations is the nonpayment of taxes or other revenues supporting the debt. In addition, certain debt obligations in the Fund may be obligations of issuers other than the State, such as those listed above. Although the State has received the highest ratings from ratings agencies, local governments and other issuers may have higher debt-to-assessment ratios, and/or greater credit risk, than the State itself, and as a result may be unable to repay their obligations. Other obligations are issued by entities which lack taxing power to repay their obligations, such as industrial development authorities and housing authorities. Certain debt may consist of obligations which are payable solely from the revenues of private institutions within one industry, such as health care. The default risk may be higher for such obligations, since any decline in that one industry could impede repayment. Finally, the economic environment has had and continues to have a substantial impact on the bond markets. The State, its political subdivisions and other conduit borrowers regularly issue bonds to fund capital projects. Since the credit crisis began, interest rates on some financings have increased and other financing sources have dried up. As a result, some local governments and other borrowers have experienced increased borrowing costs or cash flow difficulties.

As described above, State and local revenues have been reduced due, at least in part, to the current economic environment. Substantial losses in the job market, considerable declines in individual and business income taxes and transfer and other ad valorem property taxes, coupled with reduced consumer and business expenditures have already impacted State and local revenues and are likely to continue to do so for some time. The cumulative effect of the ongoing market uncertainty and the economy makes the economic outlook of the State, its political subdivisions and other borrowers challenging and at the same time, difficult to predict. While Maryland’s economy is unusually dependent on the federal government because a large percentage of Maryland residents are employed either by the federal government or in companies working with the federal government, other sectors of Maryland’s economy are experiencing the same difficulties as in the rest of the nation. Additionally, funds received by the State and any localities under ARRA are only temporarily available to support general fund commitments. Maryland and its local governments will need to decrease spending, cut employment, raise taxes and take other measures to balance their budgets for several years.

The impact of State budget cuts places an additional burden on local governments. The City of Baltimore and other political subdivisions and municipalities, many of which were already experiencing fiscal pressures due to general economic conditions and other factors, are themselves experiencing lower revenues due to lower

 

D-42


Table of Contents

income tax and property transfer tax revenues. Many of these local governments depend on State aid, and cutbacks in such aid as a result of the State’s own financial issues is adversely affecting local budgets.

Finally, the ongoing economic environment and credit crisis could affect the cash flow and ability of many conduit borrowers on bonds to service the debt service payments on their bonds; many of these entities may be unable to raise revenues due to weak consumer demand or other factors or may be experiencing higher costs (e.g., increased charity care), so the combination of higher interest rates, lack of access to capital and lower revenues or higher expenses could result in defaults on these conduit obligations. Similarly, reductions in State aid (e.g. to private educational and social or health institutions) may affect the budget of private borrowers.

North Carolina

State Economy

According to 2008 U.S. Census Bureau estimates, the State of North Carolina (“North Carolina” or the “State”) is the tenth most populous state, with a population greater than 9.2 million people. Its economy is a combination of manufacturing, agriculture, services and tourism. There is also a significant military presence in North Carolina, contributing almost 7% of the gross state product, according to a 2008 study by the North Carolina Department of Commerce.

The State is transitioning from an economy based mainly in agriculture and manufacturing (e.g. furniture and textiles) to a services and goods based economy. Greater than 50% of North Carolina’s labor force is employed in one of four industry sectors: health care and societal assistance, retail trade, manufacturing and educational services. However, the manufacturing slowdown continues to be felt in North Carolina. Manufacturing employment, which currently constitutes approximately 11.5% of total employment, has decreased significantly from 2003, when it constituted approximately 16% of total employment. While North Carolina remains the national leader in textile employment, job losses in the industry, which have been mounting for decades, are expected to continue. Nationwide, employment in the textile industry is expected to decline by 35% through the year 2016.

The national and global economic downturn has had a negative impact on North Carolina’s economy. North Carolina’s labor market has contracted significantly since January 2008, with the unemployment rate rising from 5.0% in January 2008 to 10.8% in April 2010. During the same period, total employment (as reported by the Employment Security Commission of North Carolina) decreased by over 251,000 jobs or 5.8%. The unemployment rate in April 2010 was the nation’s fourteenth highest and is slightly below the State’s highest recorded unemployment rate since the State began keeping seasonally adjusted data in 1976 (11.2% in February 2010). The unemployment rate is predicted to peak in 2010, followed by a decrease to approximately 9.0% in 2011. The education and health services sector, which is projected to expand 2.5% over the next several years, will likely lead the growth in employment, while construction and manufacturing will likely suffer longer than other industry sectors.

State Budget

The North Carolina Constitution requires that the total expenditures of the State for the fiscal period covered by the budget not exceed the total receipts during the period plus any surplus remaining in the State Treasury at the beginning of the period. The State’s budget is originally proposed by the Governor (the “Governor’s Recommended Budget”) in odd-numbered years. The Governor’s Recommended Budget is a biennial budget covering the two fiscal years starting July 1 of the year in which it is first proposed, and ending June 30 of the second year thereafter. The North Carolina General Assembly (the “General Assembly”), which has final authority to approve the State’s budget, considers the Governor’s Recommended Budget during its long session, held in odd-numbered years, making changes as it sees fit. The final budget must be ratified by both houses of the General Assembly and either signed into law by the Governor or, if the Governor vetoes the bill, overridden

 

D-43


Table of Contents

by a 3/5 vote of the General Assembly. During its short session, held in even-numbered years, the General Assembly has the power to adjust the certified budget for the second year of the biennium, based on revenues collected and economic and other considerations. The biennial budget for fiscal years 2009-2010 and 2010-2011 was ratified by the General Assembly on August 5, 2009 and signed into law by the Governor on August 7, 2009 (the “Certified Budget”).

The Certified Budget included revenue adjustments and significant revisions to the State’s tax structure, together expected to generate approximately $3 billion in additional revenue over the biennium. The majority of this additional revenue was expected to come from various changes to the State’s tax laws, including a temporary increase in the sales tax rate, temporary surtaxes on individual and corporate income, a slight broadening of the sales tax base, and an increased excise tax on tobacco and alcohol sales. The additional revenue available during the biennium, consisting in large part of these changes in tax laws, totaled $1.4 billion in fiscal year 2009-10 and $1.5 billion in fiscal year 2010-11.

On April 13, 2010, the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly released its memorandum on the revised consensus revenue forecast for the remainder of the biennium. The consensus forecast represents a revenue forecast agreed upon by the Fiscal Research Division and the North Carolina Office of State Budget and Management and provides one basis upon which the General Assembly makes adjustments to the Certified Budget during its short session. According to the consensus forecast, the revenues for 2009-2010 are expected to fall short of the Certified Budget’s forecast by $391 million. The shortfall for 2010-2011 is even more severe, with revenues forecast to be $788 million less than anticipated in the Certified Budget.

On June 30, 2010, the General Assembly ratified, and the Governor signed into law, a bill adjusting the second year of the Certified Budget, making changes to the fiscal year 2010-2011 appropriations and revenues. The fiscal year 2010-2011 adjustment combines reductions in spending across a number of State departments and agencies with adjustments to revenue, in order to close the projected revenue gap and balance the budget, as required by the North Carolina Constitution.

Financial Report

On June 15, 2010, the Office of the State Controller released its General Fund Monthly Financial Report for the period ended May 31, 2010. The General Fund had a negative balance in unreserved funds of $18.4 million, compared to a negative balance of $344.8 million as of May 31, 2009. For May 2010, North Carolina’s tax revenues, net of refunds, increased by $115.9 million, or 11.6%, compared to May 2009. For the year to date through May 31, 2010, net tax revenues reflected an increase of $644.7 million, or 4.2%. For the year to date through May 31, 2010, investment earnings declined from the same time period in 2009 by $75.6 million, or 67%, due to lower rates of return on investment and lower cash availability for investment.

Litigation

The State is currently involved in certain litigation where adverse decisions could have a material impact on State finances. Included in this litigation are the following matters, although not exhaustive of all pending matters:

In Hoke County, et al, v. State of North Carolina and State Board of Education, students and the boards of education in five North Carolina counties sought a declaration that the public school system of North Carolina, by failing to provide adequate or substantially equal educational opportunities, by denying due process of law, and by violating various public education statutes, violates the North Carolina Constitution. After its motion to dismiss was denied, the State appealed, and the North Carolina Supreme Court held that North Carolina’s funding system for public education does not unlawfully discriminate against low wealth counties. However, the court held that the North Carolina Constitution guarantees every child the opportunity to obtain a sound basic education and remanded the case for trial. On October 26, 2000, the trial court held that at-risk children in North

 

D-44


Table of Contents

Carolina are constitutionally entitled to such pre-kindergarten educational programs as may be necessary to prepare them for higher levels of education and the “sound basic education” mandated by the North Carolina Supreme Court. On March 26, 2001, the trial court ordered all parties to determine why certain school systems were succeeding without additional funding. The court re-opened the trial, in the fall of 2001, to call additional

witnesses, resulting in the trial court directing the executive and legislative branches to take corrective action necessary to ensure that every child has the opportunity to obtain a sound, basic education. The North Carolina Supreme Court affirmed the trial court, with the exception of the requirement for pre-kindergarten educational programs. The State is currently taking steps to respond to the court’s directives. The amount of resources which may ultimately be required is not yet known but, according to the Office of the State Controller’s Comprehensive Annual Financial Report for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2009, could exceed $100 million.

In N.C. School Boards Association, et al. v. Richard H. Moore, State Treasurer, et al., plaintiffs (including county school boards of Wake, Durham, Johnston, Buncombe, Edgecombe and Lenoir Counties) requested a declaration that certain payments to state administrative agencies are civil penalties which, under the North Carolina Constitution, must be paid to the schools. On December 14, 2001, the trial court granted summary judgment in favor of the plaintiffs, holding that the funds are civil fines or penalties required by the North Carolina Constitution to be paid to the public schools in the county where the violation occurred. The case was appealed, and the decision of the North Carolina Court of Appeals was substantially favorable to the State. The North Carolina Supreme Court reversed, holding that a majority of the funds in dispute are civil penalties required to be paid for the benefit of public schools. On August 8, 2008 the trial court entered judgment in favor of the plaintiffs for approximately $750 million. However, the court acknowledged that the judicial branch cannot force the State to satisfy the judgment and that any decision to do so must be made by the General Assembly.

North Carolina and seven other southeastern states are members of the Southeast Interstate Low-level Radioactive Waste Management Compact (the “Compact”) to plan and develop a site for the disposal of low-level radioactive waste generated in the member states. The responsibility for developing the first disposal site was assigned to North Carolina, which, according to certain members of the Compact and the commission which administers the Compact (the “Commission”), did not actively pursue the permitting and development of the proposed site. After North Carolina withdrew from the Compact in 1999, the other members of the Compact and the Commission demanded the repayment, with interest, of $80 million expended on the permitting, plus $10 million of future lost income, interest and attorneys’ fees. On August 5, 2002 the Commission and four member states filed a motion requesting the United States Supreme Court to hear the claim, which the Court accepted on June 16, 2003. North Carolina’s motion to dismiss was denied on November 17, 2003. The Court appointed a Special Master, which heard oral arguments on motions filed by both sides and issued his “Preliminary Report” and his “Second Report” on April 2, 2009. In his reports, the Special Master recommended, among other things, that the Court dismiss the claims seeking monetary sanctions and enter partial summary judgment finding that North Carolina did not breach the Compact by withdrawing. North Carolina and the plaintiffs filed a total of nine exceptions to the Special Master’s reports. The United States Supreme Court rejected all nine exceptions, adopting the recommendations of the Special Master, with the effect of terminating the plaintiffs’ statutory and contractual claims. However, in rejecting North Carolina’s exceptions to the Special Master’s report, the Court allowed further briefing and argument on the plaintiffs’ equitable claims (unjust enrichment, promissory estoppel, and money had and received).

In Goldston v. State of North Carolina, plaintiffs demanded the return to the Highway Trust Fund of funds transferred from the Highway Trust Fund to the General Fund to balance the state budget. The suit alleges that the transfer of funds constitutes a borrowing by the State and is unlawful and unconstitutional. The plaintiffs requested a declaration that taxes collected for the Highway Trust Fund cannot be used for other purposes. The trial court granted summary judgment for the State on all issues. On September 20, 2005, the North Carolina Court of Appeals upheld the trial court’s order. The North Carolina Supreme Court, in an opinion filed December 15, 2006, reversed the Court of Appeals, concluding that plaintiffs have standing to pursue their claims. The trial court, on March 7, 2008, again granted summary judgment in favor of the State, and again

 

D-45


Table of Contents

plaintiffs appealed. The North Carolina Court of Appeals, on September 15, 2009, held that, while the transfer by the General Assembly of $125 million from the Highway Trust Fund to the General Fund was permitted, the transfer of $80 million by the Governor exceeded his constitutional authority under the North Carolina Constitution. Both sides filed respective notices of appeal with the North Carolina Supreme Court. The plaintiffs’ notice of appeal was dismissed by the court on January 28, 2010. As of this writing, the court is yet to rule on the State’s notice of appeal.

On April 20, 2006, the State filed a motion for declaratory order against defendants Philip Morris, Inc., R.J. Reynolds Tobacco Company, and Lorillard Tobacco Company, in State of North Carolina v. Philip Morris, USA Inc., et al. The motion sought a declaration, among other things, that in 2003, North Carolina continuously had a “Qualifying Statute” in full force and effect and “diligently enforced” its provisions throughout that year in accordance with the Tobacco Master Settlement Agreement (the “MSA”), the agreement by which the largest tobacco companies make payments to various states, including North Carolina, to compensate them for smoking-related illnesses amongst their citizens. If North Carolina were not to prevail in the diligent enforcement litigation, the State may be unable to recover a portion of that year’s MSA payment. On December 4, 2006, the trial court allowed the defendants’ motion to compel arbitration of these issues. The North Carolina Court of Appeals affirmed the trial court. On March 19, 2009, the State’s appeal to the North Carolina Supreme Court was denied. The State will therefore now be required to participate in a national arbitration process with the tobacco companies and 47 other MSA states and territories, the courts of which have considered similar litigation and concluded that the issues must be arbitrated.

The Adviser believes that the information summarized above describes the more significant matters relating to the North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund. The sources of the information are the official statements of the Department of the State Treasurer of North Carolina, financial reports from the Office of the State Controller of North Carolina, other publicly available documents and oral statements from various State agencies and individuals. The Adviser has not independently verified any of the information contained in the official statements, other publicly available documents, or oral statements from various State agencies.

South Carolina

The South Carolina (State) Constitution mandates a balanced budget. If a deficit appears likely, the State Budget and Control Board, composed of the Governor, the State Treasurer, the State Comptroller General, the Chairman of the Senate Finance Committee, and the Chairman of the House Ways and Means Committee, must take action to avoid a fiscal year-end deficit. If it is determined that a fiscal year has ended with an operating deficit, the State Constitution requires that monies appropriated from the Capital Reserve Fund must be reduced to the extent necessary and applied to the year end operating deficit before withdrawing monies from the General Reserve Fund for such purpose.

By statute, the State General Assembly has provided that if monies in the Capital Reserve Fund and General Reserve Fund are insufficient to balance the Budgetary General Fund, the State Budget and Control Board is authorized to borrow the amount needed to balance the Budgetary General Fund from any department of State government with a surplus to the credit of the State department on hand in the Office of the State Treasurer. Amounts borrowed must be repaid from the General Fund no later than June 30th of the following fiscal year.

The State Constitution limits annual increases in the State appropriations to the average growth rate of the economy of the State and annual increases in the number of State employees to the average growth rate of the population of the State; provided, however, that these two limitations are subject to suspension for any one fiscal year by a special vote in each House of the General Assembly.

The State Constitution requires a General Reserve Fund that equals three percent of General Fund revenue for the latest completed fiscal year. Funds may be withdrawn from the General Reserve Fund only for the purpose of covering operating deficits of State government. The State Constitution also requires a Capital Reserve Fund equal to two percent of General Fund revenue for the latest completed fiscal year.

 

D-46


Table of Contents

 

The State Constitution requires that the General Assembly provide that, if revenue forecasts before March 1 project that revenues for the current fiscal year will be less than expenditures authorized by appropriation for the current fiscal year, the current fiscal year’s appropriation to the Capital Reserve Fund shall first be reduced to the extent necessary before any reduction is made in operating appropriations.

After March 1, monies from the Capital Reserve Fund may be appropriated by a special vote of the General Assembly to finance previously authorized capital improvement bond projects, to retire principal or interest on bonds previously issued, and to pay for capital improvements or other nonrecurring purposes. Monies in the Capital Reserve Fund not appropriated or any appropriation for a particular project or item that has been reduced due to application of the monies to a year-end deficit must lapse and be credited to the General Fund.

Fiscal Year Ended June 30, 2009

The original revenue estimate adopted by the Board of Economic Advisors for the State’s Budgetary General Fund for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2009 was $7,246.4 million, and the appropriation act estimate as enacted by the General Assembly was $6,735.7 million. On July 21, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $7,106.4 million, a decrease of $140.0 million, and a 1.9% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on August 12, 2008 reduced the State’s Capital Reserve Fund of $133.2 million as required by the State Constitution and the State’s fiscal year 2008-09 Appropriation Act. Reduction of the Capital Reserve Fund reduces appropriations to the Capital Reserve Fund to the extent necessary to avoid mandatory reductions in operating appropriations. Additionally, the State Budget and Control Board mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 3% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso and approved a 3% reduction of the Local Government Fund. Additionally, certain agency appropriations lapsed as a result of suspension of a provision that, in some years, has allowed agencies to carry forward to the next fiscal year up to 10% of their unexpended appropriations. This provision was automatically suspended for the fiscal year because of reduction of the Capital Reserve Fund. On October 8, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,692.4 million, a decrease of $414 million, and a 7.6% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate.

On October 20, 2008, the South Carolina General Assembly reconvened to amend the general appropriations act for fiscal year 2008-09, enact targeted reductions in General Fund appropriations, suspend actions of the State Budget and Control Board described above that mandated the across board reduction of General Fund appropriations and the reduction to the Local Government Fund, and validate and confirm use of the Capital Reserve Fund to offset the revenue shortfall for fiscal year 2008-09. These amendments to the 2008-09 appropriations act totaled expenditure reductions of $621.1 million, consisting of $487.9 million in targeted reductions and the $133.2 million reduction of the Capital Reserve Fund described above. On November 7, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,557.4 million, a decrease of $135.0 million, and a 9.5% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. On December 10, 2008, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,327.7 million, a decrease of $229.7 million, and a 12.7% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on December 11, 2008 mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 7% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso and approved a 7% reduction of the Local Government Fund. On March 11, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,263.3 million, a decrease of $64.4 million, and a 13.6% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-09 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on March 18, 2009 mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 2% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso. On June 11, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $6,171.3 million, a decrease of $92.0 million, and a 14.8% reduction to its original fiscal year 2008-2009 estimate.

 

D-47


Table of Contents

 

On August 14, 2009, the state’s Comptroller General reported that the state completed the 2008-09 fiscal year with a net budgetary general fund deficit of $339.5 million. Accordingly, $133.2 million of the 2008-09 Capital Reserve Fund and $108.1 million of the General Reserve Fund were applied to offset the budgetary deficit. Despite these offsets, the state completed the 2008-09 fiscal year with a $98.2 million net budgetary general fund deficit following application of reserves. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on September 3, 2009, acting pursuant to the South Carolina Code of Laws, approved a borrowing in the amount of $98,216,617, the amount needed to balance the budgetary General Fund. The borrowing was effected from surplus funds that are held in the General Deposit Account within the custody of the State Treasurer, and must be repaid on or before June 30, 2011 from the fiscal year 2010-11 General Fund.

The General Reserve Fund balance at the beginning of fiscal year 2008-09 was $95.1 million and was increased during fiscal year 2008-09 by $13.0 million. Following a $108.1 million withdrawal at year-end 2009, net of an increase during fiscal year 2009-10 by $63.9 million, the reserve was funded at $63.9 million during fiscal year 2009-10. In accordance with the State Constitution, the General Reserve Fund must be restored within three years to its full-funding amount of 3% of the State’s Budgetary General Fund revenues for the latest completed fiscal year. The State’s audited Comprehensive Annual Financial Report for fiscal year ended June 30, 2009 can be found at http://www.cg.state.sc.us.

Fiscal Year Ending June 30, 2010

The original revenue estimate adopted by the Board of Economic Advisors for the State’s budgetary General Fund for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2010 was $6,070.6 million, and the appropriation act estimate as enacted by the General Assembly was $5,714.0 million. On June 11, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,950.6 million, a decrease of $120.0 million, and a 2.0% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on June 29, 2009 reduced the State’s Capital Reserve Fund of $120.0 million (effective July 1, 2009 with subsequent ratification at its next meeting) as required by the State Constitution and the State’s fiscal year 2009-10 Appropriation Act. On July 16, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,742.3 million, a decrease of $208.3 million, and a 5.4% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on September 3, 2009 reduced the remaining balance in the Capital Reserve Fund of $7.8 million and mandated an across the board reduction of general fund appropriations of 4.04% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso or statue. On November 10, 2009, the Board of Economic Advisors further revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,620.0 million, a decrease of $122.3 million, and a 7.4% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate. In response, the State Budget and Control Board at its meeting on

December 15, 2009 mandated an across the board reduction of General Fund appropriations of 5.0% for all agencies except where prohibited by proviso or statute. The action taken by the State Budget and Control Board on December 15, 2009 included consideration for the $122.3 million revenue revision adopted by the Board of Economic Advisors on November 10, 2009, and an additional $98.2 million necessary to avoid a year-end deficit in fiscal year 2009-10 that arose as a consequence of the previously described deficiency in the budgetary General Fund when closing the books on June 30, 2009. On April 14, 2010, the Board of Economic Advisors revised its estimate of budgetary General Fund revenue to $5,559.9 million, a decrease of $60.1 million, and a 8.4% reduction to its original fiscal year 2009-10 estimate.

Through June 30, 2010, total General Fund revenue collections year to date exceeded the fiscal year 2009-10 revised revenue plan adopted on April 14, 2010 by $134.7 million or 2.5%, and were under prior year collections for the same period by $337.1 million or 5.8%.

State’s Economy

The State’s economy was predominantly dependent on agriculture until well into the 20th century; thereafter, manufacturing became the leading contributor to the gross state product. Since the 1950’s, the State’s economy has undergone a gradual transition to other activities.

 

D-48


Table of Contents

 

Real Gross Domestic Product. At December 31, 2008, principal contributors to the State’s gross domestic product were the trade, transportation and utilities industries (20%), and manufacturing sectors (18%), followed by government (15%). During the years 2003-2008, the fastest growing contributors to the State’s gross domestic product were the information industry (8.3% average annual growth), followed by professional and business services (4.9%) and education and health services (3.9%). Manufacturing declined over the period by 2.6% in South Carolina, while growing slightly in both the southeast by 0.4% and the nation by 1.2%. The State’s total gross domestic product grew at an average annual growth rate of 1.0% (v. 2.0% for southeastern states, and 2.0% for the nation) from 2003-2008.

Employment. The State’s unemployment rate in June, 2010 was 10.7%, as compared to 9.2% for the southeastern states and 9.5% for the nation. Over the past several years, the State’s unemployment rates have trended higher than the unemployment rates of other southeastern states and the nation. Largest contributors to the state’s unemployment rate are declines in manufacturing jobs and growth in the labor force. While the State’s economy is generating jobs, not enough jobs have been created to address the expanding labor force. The State’s nonagricultural employment increased 4.9% from 2003-2008, to 1.89 million by December, 2008. Strongest job growth through the period 2003-2008 occurred in the government sector (38,700, 1.2%), followed by education and health services (30,400, 3.2%), professional and business services industry (22,900 jobs, 2.3% average annual growth), trade, transportation and utilities (18,000, 1.0%), leisure and hospitality (13,500, 1.4%), and financial activities (13,200, 2.7%). During the same period, the State’s manufacturing sector declined by 67,600 jobs (2.6%).

Per Capita Income. In 2008, the State’s per capita income increased to $31,854 or 2.4% year over year, compared to an increase of 2.3% for the southeast and 2.9% for the nation. The State’s per capita income was 80.2% of the national (compared to 80.5% in 2007) and 89.0% of the southeast (compared to 88.9% in 2007) per capita income.

Population. The State’s population estimate at December 31, 2008 was almost 4.5 million. The State’s rate of growth in population was 10th fastest in the United States in 2008.

Economic Development. For the calendar year 2008, the South Carolina Department of Commerce reported $4.170 billion in new capital investments that are expected to create about 18,993 new jobs. Over the past three years, 29 percent of those jobs were in the State’s rural areas. Additional details and other information regarding economic development efforts may be found at the South Carolina Department of Commerce website, located at http://www.sccommerce.com.

Litigation

There is presently no litigation challenging the validity of any general obligation debt issued or proposed to be issued by the State. The Attorney General of the State advises that, except as described immediately below, there is neither threatened nor, to his knowledge pending, any litigation which would have any material adverse effect upon the revenues of the State.

Anonymous Taxpayer vs. South Carolina Department of Revenue. A separate anonymous taxpayer protest seeks a refund of income taxes pursuant to the statute providing for tax credits related to Economic Impact Zones. The Department of Revenue denied the refund, and the matter came before an Administrative Law Court. The Administrative Law Court allowed a $2,112,640 refund for tax year 1995, but denied the $15,323,257 refund request for tax years 1997 and 1998. Both the taxpayer and DOR are seeking judicial review by the Circuit Court.

Abbeville County School District, et. al. v. State of South Carolina. This action was originally brought seeking declaratory and injunctive relief on behalf of certain school districts, taxpayers, and individuals alleging that the State’s method of funding primary and secondary public education violated several provisions of State and federal law. The lower court dismissed the complaint on all counts. The South Carolina Supreme Court

 

D-49


Table of Contents

affirmed the lower court’s dismissal of all but one of the counts, but reversed the lower court’s dismissal of a claim arising under the education clause of the South Carolina Constitution. Specifically, the South Carolina Supreme Court held that the South Carolina Constitution requires the State to provide the opportunity for each child within the State to receive a minimally adequate education. Finding that the complaint stated a claim under this provision, the South Carolina Supreme Court remanded the case for further proceedings. Following the remand, the plaintiffs requested leave to amend their complaint in this action to add a claim for damages for past actions or omissions of the State. The Court accepted the amended complaint. The suit also contains requests for declaratory and injunctive relief that could result in the State’s providing additional monies for public education and, possibly, for other purposes. On December 29, 2005, the Court issued an order concluding that the instructional facilities in the school districts are safe and adequate to provide the opportunity for a minimally adequate education; that the State’s curriculum standards at the minimum encompass the knowledge and skills necessary to satisfy the definition for a minimally adequate education; that the State’s system of teacher licensure is sufficient to ensure at least minimally competent teachers to provide instruction consistent with the curriculum standards; that inputs into the educational system, except for the funding of early childhood intervention programs, are sufficient to satisfy the constitutional requirement; that the constitutional requirement of adequate funding is not met by the State as a result of its failure to adequately fund early childhood intervention programs; and that the students in the school districts are denied the opportunity to receive minimally adequate education because of the lack of effective and adequately funded early childhood intervention programs designed to address the impact of poverty on their educational abilities and achievements. Motions for reconsideration were denied in June, 2007, and the parties have since appealed to the South Carolina Supreme Court. The Supreme Court heard the case on June 25, 2008, but has yet to render a decision. There is no official estimate of the fiscal impact of any remedial action that will be necessitated by the findings of the Court; however, the General Assembly made provision in the 2006-07 Appropriation Act for $23 million to be expended for the purpose of initially addressing the court’s findings, and further provided for establishment of a committee to study and determine steps necessary to address those findings in future years.

Dean v. South Carolina Department of Public Safety. This class action suit seeks back wages including overtime pay for all hours during which State troopers were on call and during which they were on special duty assignments. The suit seeks payment under the Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA) and the State Wage Payment Act. The court has ruled that this is an “opt in” class, so that it includes all troopers in the State except for the less than 200 who opted out. Questions to be resolved in the case include whether a two or three year statute of limitations applies and whether the period of recovery may be extended back to 1986, the year the FLSA became applicable to the states. The court has ruled that treble damages would not apply to the State, but it has not ruled on the statute of limitations issue. Extensive discovery is proceeding. Settlement discussions have been undertaken. Under the Plaintiffs’ theory of the case, in the event of a loss to the State, the amount could exceed $12 million. The State is vigorously defending this case, but cannot predict its outcome.

Ahrens et al. v. The South Carolina Retirement System and the State of South Carolina. This case is a class action case alleging that provisions in Act No. 153 of the Acts and Joint Resolutions of the General Assembly for the year 2005 (Act No. 153) requiring working retirees in the South Carolina Retirement System (SCRS) to make employee contributions are unconstitutional and illegal. A circuit court judge has certified the class in this case and issued an order on the merits granting the Plaintiffs relief based on the equitable theory of estoppel. The circuit court denied all other claims for relief made by the plaintiffs, including their contract causes of action. The Retirement Systems and the State of South Carolina have appealed the circuit court’s order and the matter is pending before the South Carolina Supreme Court. As of March 31, 2010, the Retirement Systems had collected approximately $44.5 million in the form of retirement contributions from members of the South Carolina Retirement System who retired prior to July 1, 2005, separated from employment and returned to work. If the Plaintiffs were to ultimately prevail, most, if not all of these contributions could be refunded to the

members and no future contributions could be collected from many, if not all, of the class members. The Retirement Systems and the State of South Carolina believe their appeal is meritorious and is vigorously contesting these claims and pursuing all appellate options.

 

D-50


Table of Contents

 

Arnold et al. v. the South Carolina Police Officers Retirement System, the South Carolina Retirement System and the State of South Carolina. This case is a class action case filed on August 9, 2005, alleging that provisions in Act No. 153 requiring working retirees in the Police Officers Retirement System (PORS) to make employee contributions are unconstitutional and illegal. A circuit court judge has certified the class in this case and issued an order on the merits in the matter granting the plaintiffs relief based on the equitable theory of estoppel. The circuit court denied all other claims for relief made by the plaintiffs, including their contract causes of action. The PORS and the State of South Carolina have appealed the circuit court’s order and the matter is pending before the South Carolina Supreme Court. As of March 31, 2010, the Retirement Systems had collected approximately $14.3 million in the form of retirement contributions from members of the Police Officers Retirement System who retired prior to July 1, 2005 and returned to work. If the Plaintiffs were to ultimately prevail, most, if not all, of these contributions could be refunded to the members and no future contributions could be collected from many, if not all, of the class members. The Police Officers Retirement System and the State of South Carolina believe their appeal is meritorious and is vigorously contesting contesting these claims and pursuing all appellate options.

Other Litigation. Certain other legal actions to which the State is a party are discussed in the Notes to the State’s audited financial statements available at www.cg.state.sc.us. Those discussions accurately portray the status and potential impact of such actions, based upon information currently available to the State.

Miscellaneous

South Carolina Lottery. In November, 2000, the State’s electorate approved an amendment to the State Constitution to permit the implementation of a lottery. The amendment was adopted by the South Carolina General Assembly during its 2001 legislative session, and the lottery became operational in January, 2002. As adopted, revised Article XVII, Section 7 of the State Constitution permits lotteries and requires lottery revenues to be applied first to pay all operating expenses and prizes, with the remainder credited to a separate Education Lottery Account in the State Treasury. All account proceeds, including earnings from the investments thereof, which are required to be credited to the Education Lottery Account, must be allocated by the General Assembly only for educational purposes.

The latest information available indicates a total of $270 million net of operating expenses has been transferred to the Education Lottery Account. Monies in the Education Lottery Account must be used to supplement and not supplant existing funds for education including pre-school, elementary, high school, technical and higher teaming programs, scholarships, tuition assistance, libraries, endowed chairs at various institutions of higher learning, and acquisition of school buses.

The Adviser believes that the information summarized above describes some of the more significant matters relating to the South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund. The sources of the information are the official statements of issuers located in South Carolina, other publicly available documents, or oral statements from various State agencies. The Adviser has not independently verified any of the information contained in the official statements, other publicly available documents, or oral statements from various State agencies.

Virginia

Debt may be issued by or on behalf of the Commonwealth of Virginia (“Virginia” or the “Commonwealth”) in accordance with the provisions of Article X, Section 9 of the Virginia Constitution. Virginia counties, cities and towns may issue debt pursuant to the provisions of Article VII, Section 10 of the Virginia Constitution and the Public Finance Act of 1991 (Virginia Code Sections 15.2-2600 through 15.2-2663). Private activity bonds may be issued by various special purpose authorities, including industrial development authorities created pursuant to the Industrial Development and Revenue Bond Act (Virginia Code Sections 15.2-4900 through 15.2-4920).

 

D-51


Table of Contents

 

Section 9 of Article X of the Virginia Constitution provides for the issuance of (a) debt to which the Commonwealth’s full faith and credit is pledged (“general obligation debt”) and (b) debt of the Commonwealth not secured by the full faith and credit of the Commonwealth, but which may be supported by and paid from Commonwealth tax collections and other sources of revenue. The Commonwealth and its localities may also enter into leases and contracts that are not “debt” for constitutional purposes, even though they are classified as long-term indebtedness on the issuer’s financial statements. The repayment of such obligations is contingent upon the receipt of periodic appropriations of funds for debt service by the applicable governing body.

The Virginia Constitution authorizes general obligation debt for various purposes, and imposes certain restrictions on the amount of general obligation debt that may be issued by the Commonwealth and, in some cases, makes such debt subject to approval in a state-wide referendum election. The restrictions applicable to general obligation debt of the Commonwealth do not apply to obligations for which the full faith and credit of the Commonwealth is not pledged towards the payment of such indebtedness. Such bonds may be paid in whole or in part from revenues received as appropriations by the General Assembly from general tax and other state revenues or solely from revenues derived from revenue-producing undertakings.

The Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund invests in debt obligations issued by Virginia local governments in addition to indebtedness of the Commonwealth itself. Local government units in the Commonwealth are comprised of counties, incorporated cities, and incorporated towns. The Commonwealth is unique in that cities and counties are independent of each other and their land areas generally do not overlap for governmental jurisdiction purposes. Cities and counties each levy and collect their own taxes and provide their own services. Towns may also levy and collect taxes for town purposes but their residents remain subject to county taxes.

Local governments are authorized under the Virginia Constitution to issue general obligation debt and debt secured by revenues of a revenue-producing undertaking. Generally, debt issued by a county pledging the full faith and credit of the county is subject to voter approval in a referendum election. The aggregate amount of general obligation debt issued by a county is not otherwise limited as to amount. Debt pledging the full faith and credit of a town or city is generally subject to a state constitutional limit on the outstanding amount of such debt equal to 10 percent of the assessed valuation of the real estate subject to taxation in the city or town. Revenue bonds payable from revenues derived from a revenue-producing undertaking and certain lease or installment sale obligations that are subject to appropriation each year by the governing body of the locality are not generally subject to such limit or voter approval requirements.

The primary sources of money available to localities to pay debt service on general obligation bonds are real and personal property taxes, sales tax and business license taxes. Virginia Code Section 15.2-2659, known as the “state aid intercept provision” provides security for the repayment of general obligation indebtedness by a locality. That statute creates a mechanism by which the Commonwealth may withhold appropriated funds payable from the state to any locality for application toward any overdue debt service on general obligation bonds issued by such locality.

Numerous obligations are also issued by industrial development authorities, redevelopment and housing authorities, water and sewer authorities, community development authorities, utility service districts and other issuers created and empowered to issue bonds by Virginia statute. Such bonds are usually payable from the revenues derived from a particular undertaking and are not secured by a pledge of the faith and credit of the Commonwealth or any county, city or town. These issuers do not typically have taxing power.

The General Fund is the chief operating fund of Virginia. The General Fund of the Commonwealth derives its revenues primarily from five major taxes imposed by the Commonwealth. Such taxes are imposed in accordance with statutory and regulatory requirements upon: (1) individual and fiduciary income; (2) corporation and other business income; (3) state sales and use transactions; (4) deeds, contracts, wills and lawsuits; and (5) premiums of insurance companies. Financial accounting (under generally accepted accounting principles, or

 

D-52


Table of Contents

GAAP) and budgetary accounting (on a cash basis) is maintained on a June 30 fiscal year basis by the Commonwealth and its cities, towns and counties. The most recent audited financial statements available for the Commonwealth are for the fiscal year that ended on June 30, 2009.

The General Fund balance decreased by $1.4 billion in fiscal year 2009, a 62.9 percent reduction from fiscal year 2008. Fiscal year 2009 state revenue collections, including taxes, were $14,876,226. However, overall tax revenues decreased by 8.9 percent from fiscal year 2008 to fiscal year 2009. Individual and fiduciary income tax revenues decreased by 6.3 percent and there was a 5.6 percent decline in state sales and use taxes, a 19.8 percent decrease in corporate income taxes, a 5.2 percent decline in Public Service Corporation taxes and a 27.9 percent decrease in other taxes including deeds, contracts, wills and lawsuits, alcoholic beverage sales, tobacco products, estate and other taxes. Overall revenue and non-tax revenues decreased by 9.0 percent and by 11.5 percent, respectively. Overall expenditures declined by 3.8 percent in fiscal year 2009, compared to a 6.6 percent increase in fiscal year 2008. Individual and family service expenditures decreased by $243.0 million, or 5.7 percent, and education expenditures increased by $223.2 million, or 2.9 percent. General government expenditures decreased $120.5 million or 6.7 percent.

General Fund revenues were less than expenditures and other uses by $1.4 billion in fiscal year 2009. The General Fund unreserved balance on a budgetary basis decreased by $930.9 million, or 85.3 percent, from fiscal year 2008 to fiscal year 2009 while reserved General Fund balances decreased by $465.4 million or 41.3 percent during the same period. Total revenues and total expenditures decreased by 9.0 percent and 3.8 percent, respectively. Transfers to the General Fund increased by 4.7 percent while transfers out decreased by 19.9 percent.

Of the $823.5 million General Fund balance at June 30, 2009, $575.1 million was reserved for the Revenue Stabilization Fund. During fiscal year 2009, a $490 million withdrawal was made from the Revenue Stabilization Fund. The Revenue Stabilization Fund is segregated from the General Fund and can only be used for constitutionally authorized purposes. Virginia law directs that the Revenue Stabilization Fund be included as a component of the General Fund only for financial reporting purposes.

Under the provisions of Article X, Section 8 of the Constitution of Virginia, and based on fiscal year 2009 revenue collections, no deposits are required during fiscal year 2011. Section 2.2-1829(b) of the Code of Virginia, requires that if certain revenue criteria are met, then an additional deposit to the Revenue Stabilization Fund equal to at least one-half the mandatory deposit must be included in the Governor’s budget. The Code further requires that any such additional deposits to the Revenue Stabilization Fund shall be included in the Governor’s budget recommendations only if the estimate of General Fund revenues for the fiscal year in which the deposit is to be made is at least 5 percent greater than the actual General Fund revenues for the immediately preceding fiscal year. These conditions were not met for fiscal year 2009. The Constitutional maximum for the Revenue Stabilization Fund remains at $1.4 billion for fiscal year 2010.

On May 17, 2010, Virginia’s biennial budget was approved by the governor and enacted as the 2010-12 Appropriations Act (“Budget Bill”). The Budget Bill became effective on July 1, 2010 and includes projected General Fund revenue of $15,383,733,704 for the fiscal year ending on June 30, 2011 with appropriations of $15,376,985,189 and projected General Fund revenues of $16,017,286,924 for the fiscal year ending on June 30, 2012 with appropriations of $16,021,156,894. The biennial budget included, among other things, a $50,000,000 deposit to the Revenue Stabilization Fund scheduled for the fiscal year ending on June 30, 2012.

Virginia’s 2011-2012 biennial budget (enacted in 2010) projected total General Fund revenue available for appropriation to equal $31,401,020,628 billion for fiscal years 2011 and 2012. Lower revenue collections previously resulted in adjustments and recalibrations to the fiscal year 2009 budget. However, Virginia’s Secretary of Finance released a statement on behalf of the Governor on July 14, 2010 which indicates that the Governor anticipates a revenue surplus at the end of the 2010 fiscal year on June 30 estimated to be at least $220 million, attributable primarily to individual and corporate and business tax receipts. The final figure for the

 

D-53


Table of Contents

surplus will be made official in August after final adjustments to the financial information are made. The Governor also noted that although this is a positive development, local government finances remain under stress.

Over $5 billion of federal stimulus funds has been allocated to Virginia under the American Reinvestment and Recovery Act (ARRA). Legislation effective in April 2009 allowed appropriation and spending of ARRA funding by the Virginia General Assembly. The General Assembly has distributed allocations and appropriations across several fiscal years. Approximately 30 percent of the total available AARA funds were allocated to fiscal year 2009, with the remainder either being allocated specifically to fiscal year 2010 or remaining to be allocated to either fiscal year 2010 or 2011.

The Commonwealth’s 2009 estimated population of 7,882,590 was approximately 2.6 percent of the United States’ total. With 39,594 square miles of land area, its 2008 population density was estimated to be 196.22 persons per square mile, compared with 95.66 persons per square mile for the United States. According to the U.S. Department of Commerce, Bureau of Economic Analysis, in 2008, the Commonwealth had per capita personal income of $42,876, which was greater than the national average of $39,371, the eighth highest state average nationally and the highest of the Southeast region. According to the U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics, Virginia had a preliminary unemployment rate of 7.2 percent as of June 2009 compared to 9.5 percent nationally, making the Commonwealth the state with the ninth lowest unemployment rate in June 2009. Furthermore, Virginia had a preliminary seasonally adjusted unemployment rate of 7.0 percent as of June 2010 compared to 9.5 nationally.

As of June 30, 2010, Virginia’s bond rating is the best available from the leading ratings agencies at (Aaa/AAA/AAA from Moody’s, Standard & Poor’s, and Fitch Ratings, respectively) for long-term general obligation bonds and has maintained its top rating for such bonds for a period of time believed to be longer than any other state.

The sources of the information described above include the statutes and constitutional provisions referenced, to which reference is made for more detailed information, and official statements of the Commonwealth and other publicly available documents. The Adviser has not independently verified any of the information contained in these official statements or documents.

 

D-54


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX E — LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

Legacy Columbia funds are funds that were branded Columbia or Columbia Acorn prior to Sept. 27, 2010.

 

ColumbiaSM Acorn® Fund    Columbia Large Cap Index Fund
ColumbiaSM Acorn International®    Columbia Large Cap Value Fund
ColumbiaSM Acorn International Select®    Columbia Liberty Fund
ColumbiaSM Acorn Select®    Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio
ColumbiaSM Acorn USA®    Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund    Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio
Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II    Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio
Columbia Balanced Fund    Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund
Columbia Blended Equity Fund    Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund
Columbia Bond Fund    Columbia Marsico Global Fund
Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Marsico Growth Fund
Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund    Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund
Columbia Connecticut Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
   Columbia Maryland Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund   

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund    Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund    Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio
Columbia Convertible Securities Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund
Columbia Core Bond Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund
Columbia Corporate Income Fund (formerly known as Columbia Income Fund)    Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund
Columbia Disciplined Value Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund
Columbia Dividend Income Fund    Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund
Columbia Emerging Markets Fund   

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund   

Columbia New York Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Federal Securities Fund    Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund
Columbia Georgia Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
  

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Global Value Fund   

Columbia Oregon Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Greater China Fund    Columbia Overseas Value Fund
Columbia High Income Fund    Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund
Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund    Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund
Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund   

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate

Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund    Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund    Columbia Select Opportunities Fund
Columbia International Bond Fund    Columbia Select Small Cap Fund
Columbia International Growth Fund    Columbia Short Term Bond Fund
Columbia International Stock Fund    Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund
Columbia International Value Fund    Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund
Columbia Large Cap Core Fund    Columbia Small Cap Core Fund
Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I
Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

 

E-1


Table of Contents
Columbia Small Cap Index Fund    Columbia Technology Fund
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I    Columbia Thermostat Fund®
Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II    Columbia Total Return Bond Fund
Columbia South Carolina Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
   Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Columbia Strategic Income Fund    Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund
Columbia Strategic Investor Fund    Columbia Virginia Intermediate
Municipal Bond Fund
Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund    Columbia World Equity Fund

 

E-2


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX F — LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

Legacy RiverSource funds include RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds, funds renamed effective Sept. 27, 2010 to bear the Columbia brand, and certain other funds. Prior fund names are noted in parenthesis.

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund)

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund)

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Tax-Exempt Bond Fund)

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Asia Pacific Fund)

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Bond Fund)

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Equity Income Fund)

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Dividend Opportunity Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Emerging Markets Bond Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund)

Columbia Equity Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Equity Value Fund)

Columbia European Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle European Equity Fund)

Columbia Floating Rate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Floating Rate Fund)

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Frontier Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Global Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Global Bond Fund)

Columbia Global Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Global Equity Fund)

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund (RiverSource Global Extended Alpha Fund)

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc. (formerly known as RiverSource Government Money Market Fund, Inc.)

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource High Yield Bond Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Basic Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund II (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Moderate Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund III (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Enhanced Income Fund)

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Opportunities Fund)

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Inflation Protected Securities Fund)

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Equity Fund)

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Limited Duration Bond Fund)

Columbia Marsico Flexible Capital Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund)

Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Cash Management Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners International Select Value Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund)

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund)

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Recovery and Infrastructure Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2010 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2015 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2020 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2025 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2030 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2035 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2040 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2045 Fund)

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Large-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund (formerly known as Seligman Global Technology Fund)

Columbia Short-Term Cash Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund)

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Strategic Allocation Fund)

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund (formerly known as RiverSource U.S. Government Mortgage Fund)

RiverSource Balanced Fund

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

Seligman California Municipal High Yield Series

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

Seligman National Municipal Class

Seligman New York Municipal Class

Seligman TargETFund 2015

Seligman TargETFund 2025

Seligman TargETFund 2035

Seligman TargETFund 2045

Seligman TargETFund Core

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

Appendix B – Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Strategic Investor Fund and Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management®

 

  

COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST I

 

STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

November 1, 2010

 

Fund

              

Columbia Balanced Fund

     

Class A: CBLAX

  

Class B: CBLBX

  

Class C: CBLCX

  

Class R: CBLRX

Class R4*: —

  

Class R5*: —

  

Class Z: CBALX

  

Columbia Bond Fund

        

Class A: CNDAX

  

Class B*: —  

  

Class C: CNDCX

  

Class I: —  

Class T*: —  

  

Class W: CBDWX

  

Class Y: CBFYX

  

Class Z: UMMGX

Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     

Class A: COCTX

  

Class B: CCTBX

  

Class C: CCTCX

  

Class Z: CCTZX

        

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

     

Class A: LCCAX

  

Class B: LCCBX

  

Class C: LCCCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CCCRX

  

Class R4*: —  

  

Class T: SGIEX

  

Class W: CTRWX

Class Z: SMGIX

        

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

     

Class A: LIIAX

  

Class B: CIOBX

  

Class C: CIOCX

  

Class I: —  

Class W: CPIWX

  

Class Z: SRINX

     

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

  

Class A: LBSAX

  

Class B: LBSBX

  

Class C: LBSCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CDIRX

  

Class T: GEQAX

  

Class W: CDVWX

  

Class Z: GSFTX

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

     

Class A: EEMAX

  

Class C: EEMCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: CEMRX

Class W: CEMWX

  

Class Z: UMEMX

     

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     

Class A: EENAX

  

Class B*: —  

  

Class C: EENCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CETRX

  

Class R4*: —  

  

Class Z: UMESX

  

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

     

Class A: LHIAX

  

Class B: CHMBX

  

Class C: CHMCX

  

Class Z: SRHMX

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

     

Class A: COLHX

  

Class B: COHBX

  

Class C: CHYCX

  

Class Z: LHYZX

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Class A: LIBAX

  

Class B: LIBBX

  

Class C: LIBCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CIBRX

  

Class W: CIBWX

  

Class Z: SRBFX

  

Columbia International Bond Fund

     

Class A: CNBAX

  

Class C: CNBCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class Z: CNBZX

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

     

Class A: LEGAX

  

Class B: LEGBX

  

Class C: LEGCX

  

Class E: CLGEX

Class F: CLGFX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: CGWRX

  

Class R4*: —  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class T: GAEGX

  

Class W: CLGWX

  

Class Y: CGFYX

Class Z: GEGTX

        

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

     

Class A: CBSAX

  

Class B: CBSBX

  

Class C: CMCCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CMGRX

  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class T: CBSTX

  

Class W: CMRWX

Class Y: CMGYX

  

Class Z: CLSPX

     

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

     

Class A: CASAX

  

Class C: CASCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class Z: USPAX

 

C-6517 C (11/10)


Table of Contents

Fund

              

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

  

Class A: CREAX

  

Class B: CREBX

  

Class C: CRECX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CRSRX

  

Class R4*: —  

  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class W: CREWX

Class Z: CREEX

        

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  

Class A: ELGAX

  

Class C: ELGCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: URLGX

Class W: CSLWX

  

Class Z: UMLGX

     

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

  

Class A: LSMAX

  

Class B: LSMBX

  

Class C: LSMCX

  

Class I: —  

Class W: CSCWX

  

Class T: SSCEX

  

Class Z: SMCEX

  

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

  

Class A: CGOAX

  

Class B: CGOBX

  

Class C: CGOCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CCRIX

  

Class Y CSGYX

  

Class Z: CMSCX

  

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

  

Class A: CSMIX

  

Class B: CSSBX

  

Class C: CSSCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CSVRX

  

Class Y CSVYX

  

Class Z CSCZX

  

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

  

Class A: COSIX

  

Class B: CLSBX

  

Class C: CLSCX

  

Class R: CSNRX

Class R4*: —  

  

Class R5*: —  

  

Class W: CTTWX

  

Class Z: LSIZX

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

  

Class A: CSVAX

  

Class B: CSVBX

  

Class C: CSRCX

  

Class I: —  

Class R: CSGRX

  

Class W: CTVWX

  

Class Y CLSYX

  

Class Z: CSVFX

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

  

Class A: LUTAX

  

Class B: LUTBX

  

Class C: LUTCX

  

Class I: —  

Class Z: IUTIX

        

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

  

Class A: EVRAX

  

Class C: EVRCX

  

Class I: —  

  

Class R: URBIX

Class W: CVRWX

  

Class Z: UMBIX

     

This Statement of Additional Information (SAI) is not a prospectus, is not a substitute for reading any prospectus and is intended to be read in conjunction with a Fund’s current prospectus. Share classes marked with an “*” have not yet commenced operations as of the date of this SAI. The most recent annual report for each Fund, which includes the Fund’s audited financial statements for its most recent fiscal period, are incorporated by reference into this SAI.

Copies of the Funds’ current prospectuses and annual and semi-annual reports may be obtained without charge by writing Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, by calling Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or by visiting the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com.


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

SAI PRIMER

     1   

ABOUT THE TRUST

     5   

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

     10   

Certain Investment Activity Limits

     10   

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

     10   

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

     13   

Borrowings

     51   

Short Sales

     51   

Lending Securities

     52   

Portfolio Turnover

     53   

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

     53   

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

     59   

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

     59   

The Administrator

     75   

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

     78   

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

     81   

Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

     87   

Other Services Provided

     91   

Distribution and Servicing Plans

     93   

Codes of Ethics

     100   

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

     100   

FUND GOVERNANCE

     101   

The Board

     101   

The Officers

     116   

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

     120   

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

     120   

Brokerage Commissions

     122   

Directed Brokerage

     123   

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

     124   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

     126   

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

     128   

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

     131   

Description of the Trust’s Shares

     131   

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

     134   

Purchase and Redemption

     134   

Offering Price

     137   

TAXATION

     139   

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

     155   

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     191   

APPENDIX A—DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

     A-1   

APPENDIX B—PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

     B-1   

APPENDIX C—SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

     C-1   

APPENDIX D—DESCRIPTION OF STATE RISK FACTORS

     D-1   

APPENDIX E—LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

     E-1   

APPENDIX F—LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

     F-1   


Table of Contents

 

SAI PRIMER

The SAI is a part of the Funds’ registration statement that is filed with the SEC. The registration statement includes the Funds’ prospectuses, the SAI and certain exhibits. The SAI, and any supplements to it, can be found online at www.columbiamanagement.com, or by accessing the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

The SAI generally provides additional information about the Funds that is not required to be in the Funds’ prospectuses. The SAI expands discussions of certain matters described in the Funds’ prospectuses and provides certain additional information about the Funds that may be of interest to some investors. Among other things, the SAI provides information about:

 

   

the organization of the Trust;

 

   

the Funds’ investments;

 

   

the Funds’ investment adviser, investment subadviser(s) (if any) and other service providers, including roles and relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and conflicts of interest;

 

   

the governance of the Funds;

 

   

the Funds’ brokerage practices;

 

   

the share classes offered by the Funds;

 

   

the purchase, redemption and pricing of Fund shares; and

 

   

the application of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Investors may find this information important and helpful. If you have any questions about the Funds, please call Columbia Funds at 800.345.6611 or contact your financial advisor.

Before reading the SAI, you should consult the Glossary below, which defines certain of the terms used in the SAI.

Glossary

 

1933 Act    Securities Act of 1933, as amended
1934 Act    Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
1940 Act    Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended
Administrative Services Agreement    The administrative services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Administrator
Administrator    Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC
Adviser    Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC
Ameriprise Financial    Ameriprise Financial, Inc.
Balanced Fund    Columbia Balanced Fund
BANA    Bank of America, National Association
Bank of America    Bank of America Corporation
BFDS/DST    Boston Financial Data Services, Inc./DST Systems, Inc.
Board    The Trust’s Board of Trustees

 

1


Table of Contents
Bond Fund    Columbia Bond Fund
Brandes    Brandes Investment Partners, L.P.
CMOs    Collateralized mortgage obligations
Code    Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
Codes of Ethics    The codes of ethics adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act
Columbia Funds Complex    The mutual fund complex that is comprised of the open-end investment management companies advised by the Adviser or its affiliates and principally underwritten by Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., including funds using the RiverSource, Threadneedle and Seligman brands and funds using the Columbia brand
Columbia Funds or Columbia Funds Family    The funds within the Columbia Funds Complex using the Columbia brand
Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund    Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund
Contrarian Core Fund    Columbia Contrarian Core Fund
Corporate Income Fund    Columbia Corporate Income Fund
Custodian or State Street    State Street Bank and Trust Company
Distribution Agreement    The distribution agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Distributor
Distribution Plan(s)    One or more of the plans adopted by the Board pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act for the distribution of the Funds’ shares
Distributor    Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc.
Dividend Income Fund    Columbia Dividend Income Fund
Emerging Markets Fund    Columbia Emerging Markets Fund
Energy and Natural Resources Fund    Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund
FDIC    Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
FHLMC    The Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
Fitch    Fitch, Inc.
FNMA    Federal National Mortgage Association
The Fund(s) or a Fund    One or more of the open-end management investment companies listed on the front cover of this SAI that are series of the Trust.
GNMA    Government National Mortgage Association
High Yield Municipal Fund    Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund
High Yield Opportunity Fund    Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund
Independent Trustees    The Trustees of the Board who are not “interested persons” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds
Interested Trustee    A Trustee of the Board who is currently treated as an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Funds

 

2


Table of Contents
Intermediate Bond Fund    Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund
International Bond Fund    Columbia International Bond Fund
Investment Management Services Agreement    The investment management services agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and the Adviser
IRS    United States Internal Revenue Service
Large Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund
LIBOR    London Interbank Offered Rate
Marsico    Marsico Capital Management, LLC
Mid Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund
Moody’s    Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.
NASDAQ    National Association of Securities Dealers Automated Quotations system
NRSRO    Nationally recognized statistical ratings organization (such as Moody’s, Fitch or S&P)
NSCC    National Securities Clearing Corporation
NYSE    New York Stock Exchange
Pacific/Asia Fund    Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund
Previous Administrator    Columbia Management Advisors, LLC
Previous Adviser    Columbia Management Advisors, LLC
Previous Distributor    Columbia Management Distributors, Inc.
Previous Transfer Agent    Columbia Management Services, Inc.
Real Estate Equity Fund    Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund
REIT    Real estate investment trust
REMIC    Real estate mortgage investment conduit
RIC    A “regulated investment company,” as such term is used in the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
S&P    Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“Standard & Poor’s” and “S&P” are trademarks of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. and have been licensed for use by the Adviser. The Columbia Funds are not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by Standard & Poor’s and Standard & Poor’s makes no representation regarding the advisability of investing in the Columbia Funds).
SAI    This Statement of Additional Information
SEC    United States Securities and Exchange Commission
Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Selling Agent(s)    One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a sales support agreement with the Distributor
Servicing Agent(s)    One or more of the banks, broker/dealers or other financial institutions that have entered into a shareholder servicing agreement with the Distributor

 

3


Table of Contents
Small Cap Core Fund    Columbia Small Cap Core Fund
Small Cap Growth Fund I    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I
Small Cap Value Fund I    Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I
Strategic Income Fund    Columbia Strategic Income Fund
Strategic Investor Fund    Columbia Strategic Investor Fund
Transfer Agency Agreement    The transfer agency agreement between the Trust, on behalf of the Funds, and Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.
Transfer Agent    Columbia Management Investment Services Corp.
The Trust    Columbia Funds Series Trust I, the registered investment company in the Columbia Funds Family to which this SAI relates
Trustee(s)    One or more of the Board’s Trustees
U.S. Treasury Index Fund    Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Value and Restructuring Fund    Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

 

4


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE TRUST

The Trust is a registered investment company under the 1940 Act within the Columbia Funds Family. Columbia Funds currently include more than 100 mutual funds in major asset classes.

The Trust was organized as a Massachusetts business trust in 1987. On September 23, 2005, the Trust changed its name from Columbia Funds Trust IX to its current name. On October 13, 2003, the Trust changed its name from Liberty-Stein Roe Funds Municipal Trust to Columbia Funds Trust IX.

Funds and portfolios that bore the “Columbia” and “Columbia Acorn” brands prior to September 27, 2010 are collectively referred to herein as the Legacy Columbia funds. For a list of Legacy Columbia funds, see Appendix E. Funds and portfolios that historically bore the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle brands, including those renamed to bear the “Columbia” brand effective September 27, 2010, as well as certain other funds are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds. For a list of Legacy RiverSource funds, see Appendix F.

Funds with fiscal years ending March 31

Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, and Value and Restructuring Fund

Each of Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, and Value and Restructuring Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end management investment company. Each of the Funds is a diversified fund, except Energy and Natural Resources Fund, which is a non-diversified Fund. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of March 31st.

On March 31, 2008, each of Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, and Value and Restructuring Fund, together with the Columbia Blended Equity Fund, Columbia International Growth Fund, Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund, Columbia Select Opportunities Fund, Columbia Select Small Cap Fund, and Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund, acquired all assets and assumed all liabilities of, respectively, the following funds, each of which is a series of Excelsior Funds Trust or Excelsior Funds, Inc., as applicable: Blended Equity Fund, Core Bond Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, International Fund, Mid Cap Core Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, Equity Opportunities Fund, Small Cap Fund, Intermediate-Term Bond Fund and Value and Restructuring Fund (the Predecessor Funds), each a series of Excelsior Funds Trust or Excelsior Funds, Inc., as applicable. For periods prior to March 31, 2008, the performance and financial information shown for each Fund is the performance and financial information of the corresponding Predecessor Fund. The Funds commenced operations on March 31, 2008.

Bond Fund offers eight classes of shares; Emerging Markets Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund and Value and Restructuring Fund offer six classes of shares; Energy and Natural Resources Fund offers seven classes of shares; and Pacific/Asia Fund offers four classes of shares, each as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Corporate Income Fund and Intermediate Bond Fund

Each of Corporate Income Fund and Intermediate Bond Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of March 31st. Prior to March 27, 2006, each Fund was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust VIII, a Massachusetts business trust. The information provided for each Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to such predecessor fund. Corporate Income Fund commenced investment operations on March 5, 1986. Intermediate Bond Fund commenced investment operations on December 5, 1978.

 

5


Table of Contents

 

Intermediate Bond Fund offers seven classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. Prior to July 31, 2000, the Fund had a single class of shares. On July 14, 2000, the outstanding shares of the Fund were converted into Class S shares, and on July 31, 2000, the Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On February 1, 2002, the Fund commenced offering Class B and C shares. On July 29, 2002, the Fund’s Class S shares were redesignated as Class Z shares. On January 23, 2006, the Fund commenced offering Class R shares. Prior to September 12, 2002, the Fund invested all of its assets in the SR&F Intermediate Bond Portfolio as part of a master fund/feeder fund structure. Effective October 13, 2003, the Fund changed its name from Liberty Intermediate Bond Fund to its current name. Effective February 1, 2002, the Fund changed its name from Stein Roe Intermediate Bond Fund to Liberty Intermediate Bond Fund.

Corporate Income Fund offers six classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. Prior to August 1, 2000, the Fund had a single class of shares. On that date, the outstanding shares of the Fund were converted into Class S shares, and the Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On July 15, 2002, the Fund added Class B and C shares, redesignated its Class S shares as Class Z shares, and changed its name from Stein Roe Income Fund to Liberty Income Fund. Prior to July 15, 2002, the Fund invested all of its assets in the SR&F Income Portfolio as part of a master fund/feeder fund structure. On October 13, 2003, the Fund changed its name from Liberty Income Fund to Income Fund. Effective September 27, 2010, the Fund changed its name from Income Fund to its current name.

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

U.S. Treasury Index Fund represents a series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. U.S. Treasury Index Fund has a fiscal year end of March 31st. Prior to March 27, 2006, the Fund was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust V, a Massachusetts business trust. The information provided for U.S. Treasury Index Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to such predecessor fund. The predecessor fund commenced investment operations on June 4, 1991. The predecessor fund was the successor by reorganization to the Galaxy II U.S. Treasury Fund, a series of The Galaxy Fund II, a Massachusetts business trust organized on February 22, 1990. Class Z shares of the predecessor fund were issued in exchange for existing shares of the Galaxy II U.S. Treasury Fund. The reorganization occurred on November 25, 2002. All references to U.S. Treasury Index Fund prior to November 25, 2002 shall be deemed to refer to the Galaxy II U.S. Treasury Fund.

U.S. Treasury Index Fund offers five classes of shares, as described in “Capital Stock and Other Securities.” Effective October 13, 2003, U.S. Treasury Index Fund changed its name from Liberty U.S. Treasury Index Fund to its current name.

Funds with fiscal years ending May 31

High Yield Opportunity Fund, International Bond Fund and Strategic Income Fund

Each of High Yield Opportunity Fund, International Bond Fund and Strategic Income Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company, except for International Bond Fund, which is an open-end non-diversified management investment company. Each of the Funds has a fiscal year end of May 31st.

Prior to March 27, 2006 and September 26, 2005, respectively, High Yield Opportunity Fund and Strategic Income Fund were organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust I, a Massachusetts business trust. The information provided for High Yield Opportunity Fund and Strategic Income Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 and September 26, 2005, respectively, relates to the corresponding series of such predecessor trust.

High Yield Opportunity Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. On October 21, 1971, High Yield Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On June 8, 1992, High Yield Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class B shares. On January 15, 1996, High Yield

 

6


Table of Contents

Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class C shares. On January 8, 1999, High Yield Opportunity Fund commenced offering Class Z shares. Effective October 13, 2003, High Yield Opportunity Fund changed its name from Liberty High Yield Securities Fund to its current name. Effective July 14, 2000, High Yield Opportunity Fund changed its name from Colonial High Yield Securities Fund to Liberty High Yield Securities Fund.

International Bond Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. On December 1, 2008, International Bond Fund commenced offering Class A, C and Z shares.

Strategic Income Fund offers eight classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. On April 22, 1977, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On May 15, 1992, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class B shares. On July 1, 1997, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class C shares. On November 2, 1998, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class J shares. On June 12, 2009, Strategic Income Fund stopped accepting Class J share purchases. On July 27, 2009, Strategic Income Fund liquidated and terminated Class J shares. On January 29, 1999, Strategic Income Fund commenced offering Class Z shares.

Funds with fiscal years ending June 30

High Yield Municipal Fund and Small Cap Value Fund I

Each of High Yield Municipal Fund and Small Cap Value Fund I represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of such Funds has a fiscal year end of June 30th.

High Yield Municipal Fund commenced investment operations on March 5, 1984. The Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. Prior to August 1, 2000, the Fund had a single class of shares. On that date, the outstanding shares of the Fund were converted into Class S shares, and the Fund commenced offering Class A shares. On July 15, 2002, the Fund added Class B and Class C shares and redesignated Class S shares as Class Z shares. Also on July 15, 2002, the Fund changed its name from “Stein Roe High-Yield Municipals Fund” to “Liberty High Yield Municipal Fund” and the Fund’s Class A shares changed their name from “Liberty High Income Municipals Fund, Class A,” to Class A shares. The Fund invested all of its assets in SR&F High Yield Municipals Portfolio as part of a master fund/feeder fund structure through July 15, 2002. The Fund changed its name from “Liberty High Yield Municipal Fund” to its current name effective October 13, 2003.

Small Cap Value Fund I commenced operations on July 25, 1986. Small Cap Value Fund I was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust VI, a Massachusetts business trust, prior to its reorganization as a series of the Trust on March 27, 2006. The information provided for Small Cap Value Fund I in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to Columbia Funds Trust VI.

Small Cap Value Fund I offers seven classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities. The Fund changed its name from “Colonial Small Stock Fund” to “Colonial Small-Cap Value Fund” on February 28, 1997, and from “Colonial Small-Cap Value Fund” to “Liberty Small-Cap Value Fund” on July 14, 2000. The Fund changed its name from “Liberty Small-Cap Value Fund” to “Columbia Small Cap Value Fund” on October 13, 2003. The Fund changed its name from “Columbia Small Cap Value Fund” to its current name effective October 10, 2005.

Funds with fiscal years ending August 31

Balanced Fund, Mid Cap Growth Fund, Small Cap Growth Fund I, and Strategic Investor Fund

Each of Balanced Fund, Mid Cap Growth Fund, Small Cap Growth Fund I and Strategic Investor Fund is a diversified series of the Trust and has a fiscal year end of August 31st.

 

7


Table of Contents

 

Prior to March 27, 2006, each Fund was organized as an Oregon corporation. The information provided for these Funds in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to the predecessor Oregon corporation funds.

Balanced Fund and Small Cap Growth Fund I offer seven classes of shares, Mid Cap Growth Fund offers ten classes of shares and Strategic Investor Fund offers eight classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Funds with fiscal years ending September 30

Contrarian Core Fund, Dividend Income Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, and Small Cap Core Fund

Each of Contrarian Core Fund, Dividend Income Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, and Small Cap Core Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end diversified management investment company. Each of such Funds has a fiscal year end of September 30th.

Large Cap Growth Fund commenced operations on December 14, 1990; commenced operations on September 1, 1988; and Dividend Income Fund commenced operations on March 4, 1998. Contrarian Core Fund and Small Cap Core Fund commenced operations on December 14, 1992, as separate portfolios (collectively, the Predecessor Shawmut Funds) of The Shawmut Funds. On December 4, 1995, the Predecessor Shawmut Funds were reorganized as new portfolios of the Galaxy Fund. Prior to the reorganization, the Predecessor Shawmut Funds offered and sold shares of beneficial interest that were similar to the Galaxy Fund’s Trust Shares and Retail A Shares. Contrarian Core Fund changed its name from Columbia Common Stock Fund to its current name on November 14, 2008.

Each Fund is the successor to a separate series of the Galaxy Fund, a Massachusetts business trust organized on March 31, 1986. On November 18, 2002, November 25, 2002 and December 9, 2002, the series of the Galaxy Fund to which the Funds succeeded were reorganized as separate series of the Liberty-Stein Roe Investment Trust. Class A shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Prime A Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund, Class B shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Prime B Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund, Class T shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Retail A Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund, Class G shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Retail B Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund and Class Z shares of the Funds were issued in exchange for Trust Shares of the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund. (Prime A and Prime B Shares, Retail A and Retail B Shares and Trust Shares together are referred to herein as the Predecessor Classes). On August 8, 2007, Class G shares of the Funds were converted to Class T shares. Information provided with respect to each Fund for periods prior to such Fund’s inception relates to the predecessor series of the Galaxy Fund. Further, information provided with respect to each class of each Fund prior to such Fund’s inception relates to the Predecessor Classes of such class.

Contrarian Core Fund offers nine classes of shares; Dividend Income Fund offers eight classes of shares; Large Cap Growth Fund offers thirteen classes of shares; and Small Cap Core Fund offers seven classes of shares, each as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Fund with fiscal year ending October 31

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund represents a separate series of the Trust and is an open-end management investment company. Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund is a “diversified” fund and has a fiscal year end of October 31st.

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund was originally organized as a series of another Massachusetts business trust prior to its reorganization as a series of the Trust. Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund was reorganized as a series of the Trust on March 27, 2006 (the Tax-Exempt Fund Reorganization Date). Prior to March 27, 2006, Connecticut

 

8


Table of Contents

Tax-Exempt Fund was organized as a series of Columbia Funds Trust V. Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund commenced investment operations on November 1, 1991. The information provided for Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund in this SAI for periods prior to the Tax-Exempt Fund Reorganization Date relates to the predecessor funds of the same names. The trust of which Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund was previously a series changed its name from Liberty Funds Trust V to Columbia Funds Trust V on October 13, 2003.

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund offers four classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

Fund with fiscal year ending December 31

Real Estate Equity Fund

Real Estate Equity Fund represents a series of the Trust and is an open-end non-diversified management investment company. In 2009, Real Estate Equity Fund changed its fiscal year end from August 31 to December 31.

Prior to March 27, 2006, Real Estate Equity Fund was organized as an Oregon corporation. The information provided for the Fund in this SAI for periods prior to March 27, 2006 relates to the predecessor Oregon corporation.

Real Estate Equity Fund offers nine classes of shares, as described in Capital Stock and Other Securities.

 

9


Table of Contents

 

ABOUT THE FUNDS’ INVESTMENTS

The investment objectives, principal investment strategies (i.e., as used in this SAI and the corresponding prospectuses, a strategy which generally involves the ability to invest 10% or more of a Fund’s total assets) and related principal risks for each Fund are discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Certain Investment Activity Limits

The overall investment and other activities of the Adviser and its affiliates may limit the investment opportunities for each Fund in certain markets where limitations are imposed by regulators upon the amount of investment by affiliated investors, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. From time to time, each Fund’s activities also may be restricted because of regulatory restrictions applicable to the Adviser and its affiliates and/or because of their internal policies. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

The following discussion of “fundamental” and “non-fundamental” investment policies and limitations for each Fund supplements the discussion of investment policies in the Funds’ prospectuses. A fundamental policy may be changed only with Board and shareholder approval. A non-fundamental policy may be changed by the Board and does not require shareholder approval, but may require notice to shareholders in certain instances.

Unless otherwise noted, whenever an investment policy or limitation states a maximum percentage of a Fund’s assets that may be invested in any security or other asset, or sets forth a policy regarding an investment standard, compliance with such percentage limitation or standard will be determined solely at the time of the Fund’s acquisition of such security or asset. Borrowings and other instruments that may give rise to leverage and the restriction on investing in illiquid securities are monitored on an ongoing basis.

Fundamental Investment Policies

The 1940 Act provides that a “vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities” means the affirmative vote of the lesser of (1) more than 50% of the outstanding shares of a Fund, or (2) 67% or more of the shares present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding shares are represented at the meeting in person or by proxy. The following fundamental investment policies cannot be changed without such a vote.

Each Fund may not, as a matter of fundamental policy:

 

  1. Underwrite any issue of securities issued by other persons within the meaning of the 1933 Act except when it might be deemed to be an underwriter either: (i) in connection with the disposition of a portfolio security; or (ii) in connection with the purchase of securities directly from the issuer thereof in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective. This restriction shall not limit the Fund’s ability to invest in securities issued by other registered investment companies;

 

  2. Purchase or sell real estate, except each Fund may: (i) purchase securities of issuers which deal or invest in real estate, (ii) purchase securities which are secured by real estate or interests in real estate and (iii) hold and dispose of real estate or interests in real estate acquired through the exercise of its rights as a holder of securities which are secured by real estate or interests therein;

 

  3. Purchase or sell commodities, except that each Fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective: (i) invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, (ii) purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and (iii) enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This limitation does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts;

 

10


Table of Contents

 

  4.

With the exception of Real Estate Equity Fund, which will invest at least 65% of the value of its total assets in securities of companies principally engaged in the real estate industrya, purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: (i) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisionsb; (ii) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief; and (iii) under normal market conditions, Energy and Natural Resources Fund will invest at least 25% of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase in the securities of issuers conducting their principal business activities in the energy and other natural resources groups of industriesc;

 

  5. Make loans, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief;

 

  6. Borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief; and

 

  7. With the exception of Energy and Natural Resources Fund, International Bond Fund and Real Estate Equity Fund, purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (i) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations and (ii) a Fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.

As a matter of fundamental policy, under normal circumstances, Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund invests at least 80% of total assets in state bonds, subject to applicable state requirements.

 

a

In determining whether a purchase by Real Estate Equity Fund would cause the Fund to have invested less than 65% of the value of its total assets in securities of companies principally engaged in the real estate industry, the Adviser currently uses the Global Industry Classification Standard (“GICS”) produced by S&P and MSCI Inc.

b

For purposes of determining whether International Bond Fund has invested 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry pursuant to fundamental investment policy (4) above, the Fund will consider each foreign government to be conducting its business activities in a separate industry, and will consider a security to have been issued by a foreign government if (i) the security is issued directly by such government, (ii) the security is issued by an agency, instrumentality or authority that is backed by the full faith and credit of such foreign government or (iii) the security is issued by an entity the assets and revenues of which the Adviser determines are not separate from such foreign government. The Fund generally will treat supranational entities as issuers separate and distinct from any foreign government, so long as such entities do not fall within the characteristics described in item (iii) above. If any other security is guaranteed as to payment of principal and/or interest by a foreign government, then the Fund will generally treat the guarantee as a separate security issued by such foreign government.

c

In determining whether Energy and Natural Resources Fund has invested at least 25% of the value of its total assets in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the energy and other natural resources groups of industries, the Adviser currently uses the Global Industry Classification Standard (“GICS”) produced by S&P and MSCI Inc. The Adviser currently considers companies in each of the indicated GICS industry groups to be within the energy and other natural resources groups of industries: (i) Energy, (ii) Utilities, and (iii) Materials, but limited to companies in the following

 

11


Table of Contents
 

GICS industries and sub-industries: the Chemicals industry (companies that primarily produce or distribute industrial and basic chemicals, including the Commodity Chemicals, Diversified Chemicals, Fertilizers & Agriculture Chemicals, Industrial Gases, and Specialty Chemicals sub-industries), the Metals & Mining industry (companies that primarily produce, process, extract, or distribute precious or basic metals or minerals, including the Aluminum, Diversified Metals & Mining, Gold, Precious Metals & Minerals, and Steel sub-industries), and the Paper & Forest Products industry (companies that primarily cultivate or manufacture timber or wood-related products or paper products, including the Forest Products and Paper Products sub-industries).

Non-Fundamental Investment Policies

 

Fund

   May Not Invest
more than 15%
of its net assets
in illiquid
securitiesa
     May not sell
securities
shortb
     May not
purchase
securities of
other investment
companiesc
     May not purchase
securities of
companies for
purpose of
exercising controld
     Provides 60
day notice in
connection with
Rule 35d-1
changese
 

Balanced Fund

   ü            ü           

Bond Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   ü         ü         ü           

Contrarian Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Corporate Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Dividend Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Emerging Markets Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

High Yield Municipal Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

High Yield Opportunity Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Intermediate Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

International Bond Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Large Cap Growth Fund

   ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Pacific/Asia Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Real Estate Equity Fund

   ü            ü           

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   ü            ü            ü     

Small Cap Core Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   ü            ü            ü     

Small Cap Value Fund I

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Strategic Income Fund

   ü         ü         ü           

Strategic Investor Fund

   ü            ü           

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

   ü         ü         ü            ü     

Value and Restructuring Fund

   ü            ü           

 

a

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, invest more than 15% of their net assets in illiquid securities. “Illiquid Securities” is defined in accordance with the SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is a security which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which the fund has valued the security.

b

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, sell securities short, except as permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

c

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, purchase securities of other investment companies except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations

 

12


Table of Contents
 

thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief. If shares of one of these Funds are purchased by another fund in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act, for so long as shares of the Fund are held by such fund, the Fund will not purchase securities of a registered open-end investment company or registered unit investment trust in reliance on Section 12(d)(1)(F) or Section 12(d)(1)(G) of the 1940 Act.

d

Funds with a check mark in this column may not, as a matter of non-fundamental policy, purchase securities of companies for the purpose of exercising control.

e

To the extent a Fund with a check mark in this column is subject to Rule 35d-1 under the 1940 Act (the Names Rule), and does not otherwise have a fundamental investment policy in place to comply with the Names Rule, such Fund has adopted the following non-fundamental policy: Shareholders will receive at least 60 days’ notice of any change to the Fund’s investment objective or principal investment strategies made in order to comply with the Names Rule. The notice will be provided in plain English in a separate written document, and will contain the following prominent statement or similar statement in bold-face type: “Important Notice Regarding Change in Investment Policy.” This statement will appear on both the notice and the envelope in which it is delivered, unless it is delivered separately from other communications to investors, in which case the statement will appear either on the notice or the envelope in which the notice is delivered.

Permissible Investments and Related Risks

Each Fund’s prospectuses identify and summarize the individual types of securities in which the Fund invests as part of its principal investment strategies and the principal risks associated with such investments.

The table below identifies certain types of securities in which each Fund is permitted to invest, including certain types of securities that are described in each Fund’s prospectuses. A Fund generally has the ability to invest 10% or more of its total assets in each type of security described in its prospectuses (and in each sub-category of such security type described in this SAI). To the extent that a type of security identified below for a Fund is not described in the Fund’s prospectuses (or as a sub-category of such security type in this SAI), the Fund generally invests less than 10% of the Fund’s total assets in such security type.

Information about individual types of securities (including certain of their associated risks) in which some or all of the Funds may invest is set forth below. Each Fund’s investment in these types of securities is subject to its investment objective and fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies.

Temporary Defensive Positions. Each Fund may temporarily invest in money market instruments or hold cash. It may do so without limit, when the Adviser or the Fund’s subadviser, if applicable: (i) believes that the market conditions are not favorable for profitable investing; (ii) is unable to locate favorable investment opportunities; or (iii) determines that a temporary defensive position is advisable or necessary in order to meet anticipated redemption requests, or for other reasons. While a Fund engages in such strategies, it may not achieve its investment objective. See also About the Funds’ Investments – Permissible Investments and Related Risks – Money Market Instruments.

 

13


Table of Contents

 

Permissible Fund Investments

 

Investment Type

  Balanced
Fund
     Bond
Fund
     Connecticut
Tax-Exempt
Fund
    Contrarian  Core
Fund
    Corporate
Income

Fund
    Dividend
Income
Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Bank Obligations

             

Domestic

  ü         ü         ü           

Foreign

  ü         ü         ü           

Common Stock

  ü         ü         ü        ü          ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

     ü              

Derivatives

             

Index or Linked Securities
(Structured Products)

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü         ü           ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts
(Funding Arrangements)

     ü              

Illiquid Securities

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü              ü          ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Municipal Securities

  ü         ü         ü          ü       

Participation Interests

  ü         ü              

Preferred Stock

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü         ü           ü          ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü         ü           ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

     ü         ü          ü       

Stripped Securities

  ü         ü              

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü         ü         ü        ü          ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü         ü         ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

14


Table of Contents

 

Investment Type

  Emerging
Markets

Fund
    Energy and
Natural
Resources
Fund
    High Yield
Municipal
Fund
    High Yield
Opportunity
Fund
    Intermediate
Bond Fund
    International
Bond Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Bank Obligations

           

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Derivatives

           

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Dollar Rolls

  ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü          ü        ü        ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Municipal Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Participation Interests

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Standby Commitments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Stripped Securities

  ü        ü          ü          ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

 

15


Table of Contents

 

Investment Type

  Large Cap
Growth
Fund
     Mid Cap
Growth
Fund
     Pacific/Asia
Fund
     Real  Estate
Equity

Fund
     Select Large
Cap Growth
Fund
     Small Cap
Core Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

        ü            ü        

Bank Obligations

                

Domestic

     ü         ü         ü         ü        

Foreign

     ü         ü         ü         ü        

Common Stock

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

        ü            ü        

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

        ü            ü        

Derivatives

                

Index or Linked Securities
(Structured Products)

  ü            ü            ü         ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Dollar Rolls

        ü            ü        

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

        ü            ü        

Illiquid Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

        ü            ü        

Money Market Instruments

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

        ü            ü        

Municipal Securities

        ü            ü        

Participation Interests

        ü            ü        

Preferred Stock

  ü         ü         ü            ü         ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

  ü            ü            ü         ü     

Standby Commitments

        ü            ü        

Stripped Securities

        ü            ü        

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

  ü            ü            ü         ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü         ü         ü         ü         ü         ü     

 

16


Table of Contents

 

Investment Type

  Small Cap
Growth

Fund I
    Small Cap
Value

Fund  I
    Strategic
Income

Fund
    Strategic
Investor

Fund
    U.S.
Treasury
Fund
    Value and
Restructuring
Fund
 

Asset-Backed Securities

    ü        ü            ü     

Bank Obligations

           

Domestic

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Common Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Convertible Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Corporate Debt Securities

    ü        ü            ü     

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

      ü            ü     

Derivatives

           

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

    ü        ü            ü     

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Swap Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Dollar Rolls

      ü            ü     

Foreign Currency Transactions

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Foreign Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Arrangements)

      ü            ü     

Illiquid Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Initial Public Offerings

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Investments in Other Investment Companies

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

      ü            ü     

Money Market Instruments

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

      ü            ü     

Municipal Securities

      ü            ü     

Participation Interests

      ü            ü     

Preferred Stock

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Repurchase Agreements

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

    ü        ü            ü     

Standby Commitments

    ü        ü            ü     

Stripped Securities

      ü            ü     

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

Warrants and Rights

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü     

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

    ü        ü            ü     

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

  ü        ü        ü        ü          ü     

Asset-Backed Securities

Asset-backed securities represent interests in, or debt instruments that are backed by, pools of various types of assets that generate cash payments generally over fixed periods of time. Such securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying assets (less fees paid to the

 

17


Table of Contents

originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying assets effectively pass through to such security holders. Asset-backed securities typically are created by an originator of loans or owner of accounts receivable that sells such underlying assets to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying assets, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Asset-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in asset-backed securities is subject to certain risks. For example, the value of asset-backed securities may be affected by, among other factors, changes in: interest rates, the market’s assessment of the quality of underlying assets, the creditworthiness of the servicer for the underlying assets, information concerning the originator of the underlying assets, or the creditworthiness or rating of the entities that provide any supporting letters of credit, surety bonds, derivative instruments, or other credit enhancement. The value of asset-backed securities also will be affected by the exhaustion, termination or expiration of any credit enhancement.

Declining or low interest rates may lead to a more rapid rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in accelerated payments on asset-backed securities that then would be reinvested at a lesser rate of interest. Rising or high interest rates tend to lead to a slower rate of repayment on the underlying assets, resulting in slower than expected payments on asset-backed securities that can, in turn, lead to a decline in value. The impact of changing interest rates on the value of asset-backed securities may be difficult to predict and result in greater volatility. Holders of asset-backed securities generally have no recourse against the originator of the underlying assets in the event of a default on the underlying assets. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of asset-backed securities, backed by pools of receivables such as mortgage loans, may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or an underlying obligor has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for asset-backed securities that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of an asset-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be.

Bank Obligations (Domestic and Foreign)

Bank obligations include certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances, time deposits and promissory notes that earn a specified rate of return and may be issued by (i) a domestic branch of a domestic bank, (ii) a foreign branch of a domestic bank, (iii) a domestic branch of a foreign bank or (iv) a foreign branch of a foreign bank. Bank obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

Certificates of deposit, or so-called CDs, typically are interest-bearing debt instruments issued by banks and have maturities ranging from a few weeks to several years. Bankers’ acceptances are time drafts drawn on and accepted by banks, are a customary means of effecting payment for merchandise sold in import-export transactions and are a general source of financing. Yankee dollar certificates of deposit are negotiable CDs issued in the United States by branches and agencies of foreign banks. Eurodollar certificates of deposit are CDs issued by foreign (mainly European) banks with interest and principal paid in U.S. dollars. Such CDs typically have maturities of less than two years and have interest rates that typically are pegged to the London Interbank Offered Rate or LIBOR. A time deposit can be either a savings account or CD that is an obligation of a financial institution for a fixed term. Typically, there are penalties for early withdrawals of time deposits. Promissory notes are written commitments of the maker to pay the payee a specified sum of money either on demand or at a fixed or determinable future date, with or without interest.

 

18


Table of Contents

 

Bank investment contracts are issued by banks. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of a bank. The bank then credits to the Fund payments at floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund also may hold funds on deposit with its custodian for temporary purposes.

Investing in bank obligations is subject to certain risks. Certain bank obligations, such as some CDs, are insured by the FDIC up to certain specified limits. Many other bank obligations, however, are neither guaranteed nor insured by the FDIC or the U.S. Government. These bank obligations are “backed” only by the creditworthiness of the issuing bank or parent financial institution. Domestic and foreign banks are subject to different governmental regulation. Accordingly, certain obligations of foreign banks, including Eurodollar and Yankee dollar obligations, involve different investment risks than those affecting obligations of domestic banks, including, among others, the possibilities that: (i) their liquidity could be impaired because of political or economic developments; (ii) the obligations may be less marketable than comparable obligations of domestic banks; (iii) a foreign jurisdiction might impose withholding and other taxes at high levels on interest income; (iv) foreign deposits may be seized or nationalized; (v) foreign governmental restrictions such as exchange controls may be imposed, which could adversely affect the payment of principal or interest on those obligations; (vi) there may be less publicly available information concerning foreign banks issuing the obligations; and (vii) the reserve requirements and accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards, practices and requirements applicable to foreign banks may differ from those applicable to domestic banks. Foreign banks generally are not subject to examination by any U.S. Government agency or instrumentality.

Common Stock

Common stock represents a unit of equity ownership of a corporation. Owners typically are entitled to vote on the selection of directors and other important corporate governance matters, and to receive dividend payments, if any, on their holdings. However, ownership of common stock does not entitle owners to participate in the day-to-day operations of the corporation. Common stocks of domestic and foreign public corporations can be listed, and their shares traded, on domestic stock exchanges, such as the NYSE or the NASDAQ Stock Market. Domestic and foreign corporations also may have their shares traded on foreign exchanges, such as the London Stock Exchange or Tokyo Stock Exchange. Common stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in common stocks is subject to certain risks. Stock market risk, for example, is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods of time, perhaps substantially or unexpectedly. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when stock prices generally rise and periods when stock prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and fall based on factors specific to each company, such as changes in earnings or management, as well as general economic and market factors.

If a corporation is liquidated, the claims of secured and unsecured creditors and owners of debt securities and “preferred” stock take priority over the claims of those who own common stock.

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to the particular type of company issuing the common stock. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price swings than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, may be more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Common stocks of these types of companies may have a higher potential for gains, but also may be subject to greater risk of loss.

Investing in common stocks also poses risks applicable to a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of common stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably

 

19


Table of Contents

affect, an industry, the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the share prices of the common stocks of companies in that industry to decline quickly.

Convertible Securities

Convertible securities include bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks or other securities that may be converted or exchanged (by the holder or by the issuer) into shares of the underlying common stock (or cash or securities of equivalent value) at a stated exchange ratio or predetermined price (the conversion price). As such, convertible securities combine the investment characteristics of debt securities and equity securities. A holder of convertible securities is entitled to receive the income of a bond, debenture or note or the dividend of a preferred stock until the conversion privilege is exercised. The market value of convertible securities generally is a function of, among other factors, interest rates, the rates of return of similar nonconvertible securities and the financial strength of the issuer. The market value of convertible securities tends to decline as interest rates rise and, conversely, to rise as interest rates decline. However, a convertible security’s market value tends to reflect the market price of the common stock of the issuing company when that stock price approaches or is greater than its conversion price. As the market price of the underlying common stock declines, the price of the convertible security tends to be influenced more by the rate of return of the convertible security. Because both interest rate and market movements can influence their value, convertible securities generally are not as sensitive to changes in interest rates as similar debt securities nor generally are they as sensitive to changes in share price as their underlying common stock. Convertible securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in convertible securities is subject to certain risks. Certain convertible securities, particularly securities that are convertible into securities of an issuer other than the issuer of the convertible security, may be illiquid and, therefore, may be more difficult to resell in a timely fashion or for a fair price, which could result in investment losses. Certain convertible securities may have a mandatory conversion feature, pursuant to which the securities convert automatically into common stock or other equity securities (of the same or a different issuer) at a specified date and a specified exchange ratio. Certain convertible securities may be convertible at the option of the issuer, which may require a holder to convert the security into the underlying common stock, even at times when the value of the underlying common stock or other equity security has declined substantially. In addition, some convertible securities may be rated below investment grade or may not be rated and, therefore, may be considered speculative investments. Companies that issue convertible securities frequently are small- and mid-capitalization companies and, accordingly, carry the risks associated with such companies. In addition, the credit rating of a company’s convertible securities generally is lower than that of its conventional debt securities. Convertible securities are senior to equity securities and have a claim to the assets of an issuer prior to the holders of the issuer’s common stock in the event of liquidation but generally are subordinate to similar non-convertible debt securities of the same issuer. Some convertible securities are particularly sensitive to changes in interest rates when their predetermined conversion price is much higher than the price for the issuing company’s common stock.

Corporate Debt Securities

Corporate debt securities are fixed income securities typically issued by businesses to finance their operations. Notes, bonds, debentures and commercial paper are the most common types of corporate debt securities, with the primary difference being their interest rates, maturity dates and secured or unsecured status. Commercial paper has the shortest term and usually is unsecured. The broad category of corporate debt securities includes debt issued by domestic or foreign companies of all kinds, including those with small-, mid- and large-capitalizations. The category also includes bank loans, as well as assignments, participations and other interests

 

20


Table of Contents

in bank loans. Corporate debt securities may be rated investment grade or below investment grade and may be structured as fixed-, variable or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Extendible commercial notes (ECNs) are very similar to commercial paper except that with ECNs, the issuer has the option to extend the notes’ maturity. ECNs are issued at a discount rate, with an initial redemption of not more than 90 days from the date of issue. If ECNs are not redeemed by the issuer on the initial redemption date, the issuer will pay a premium (step-up) rate based on the ECN’s credit rating at the time.

Because of the wide range of types and maturities of corporate debt securities, as well as the range of creditworthiness of issuers, corporate debt securities can have widely varying risk/return profiles. For example, commercial paper issued by a large established domestic corporation that is rated by an NRSRO as investment grade may have a relatively modest return on principal but present relatively limited risk. On the other hand, a long-term corporate note issued, for example, by a small foreign corporation from an emerging market country that has not been rated by an NRSRO may have the potential for relatively large returns on principal but carries a relatively high degree of risk.

Investing in corporate debt securities is subject to certain risks including, among others, credit and interest rate risk. Credit risk is the risk that a Fund could lose money if the issuer of a corporate debt security is unable to pay interest or repay principal when it becomes due. Some corporate debt securities that are rated below investment grade by an NRSRO generally are considered speculative because they present a greater risk of loss, including default, than higher quality debt securities. The credit risk of a particular issuer’s debt security may vary based on its priority for repayment. For example, higher ranking (senior) debt securities have a higher priority than and, therefore, may be paid in full before, lower ranking (subordinated) securities. In addition, in the event of bankruptcy, holders of higher-ranking senior securities may receive amounts otherwise payable to the holders of more junior securities. Interest rate risk is the risk that the value of certain corporate debt securities will tend to fall when interest rates rise. In general, corporate debt securities with longer terms tend to fall more in value when interest rates rise than do corporate debt securities with shorter terms.

Custody Receipts and Trust Certificates

Custody receipts and trust certificates are derivative products that evidence direct ownership in a pool of securities. Typically, a sponsor will deposit a pool of securities with a custodian in exchange for custody receipts evidencing interests in those securities. The sponsor generally then will sell the custody receipts or trust certificates in negotiated transactions at varying prices. Each custody receipt or trust certificate evidences the individual securities in the pool and the holder of a custody receipt or trust certificate generally will have all the rights and privileges of owners of those securities.

Investing in custody receipts and trust certificates is subject to certain risks. Custody receipts and trust certificates generally are subject to the same risks as the securities evidenced by the receipts or certificates. Custody receipts and trust certificates also may be less liquid than the underlying securities.

Derivatives

General

Derivatives are financial instruments whose values are based on (or “derived” from) traditional securities (such as a stock or a bond), assets (such as a commodity, like gold), reference rates (such as LIBOR) or market indices (such as the S&P 500® Index). Some forms of derivatives, such as exchange-traded futures and options on securities, commodities, or indices, are traded on regulated exchanges. These types of derivatives are

 

21


Table of Contents

standardized contracts that can easily be bought and sold, and whose market values are determined and published daily. Non-standardized derivatives, on the other hand, tend to be more specialized or complex, and may be harder to value. Derivatives afford leverage and, when used properly, can enhance returns and be useful in hedging portfolios. Some common types of derivatives include futures; options; options on futures; forward foreign currency exchange contracts; forward contracts on securities and securities indices; linked securities and structured products; CMOs; stripped securities; warrants; swap agreements and swaptions.

A Fund may use derivatives for a variety of reasons, including, for example: (i) to enhance its return; (ii) to attempt to protect against possible changes in the market value of securities held in or to be purchased for its portfolio resulting from securities markets or currency exchange rate fluctuations (i.e., to hedge); (iii) to protect its unrealized gains reflected in the value of its portfolio securities; (iv) to facilitate the sale of such securities for investment purposes; (v) to reduce transaction costs; and/or (vi) to manage the effective maturity or duration of its portfolio.

A Fund’s use of derivatives presents risks different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in traditional securities. The use of derivatives can lead to losses because of adverse movements in the price or value of the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate, which may be magnified by certain features of the derivatives. These risks are heightened when a Fund uses derivatives to enhance its return or as a substitute for a position or security, rather than solely to hedge or offset the risk of a position or security held by a Fund. There is also a risk that the derivative will not correlate well with the security for which it is substituting. A Fund’s use of derivatives to leverage risk also may exaggerate a loss, potentially causing a Fund to lose more money than if it had invested in the underlying security, or limit a potential gain. The success of management’s derivative strategies will depend on its ability to assess and predict the impact of market or economic developments on the underlying security, asset, index or reference rate and the derivative itself, without necessarily the benefit of observing the performance of the derivative under all possible market conditions. Other risks arise from a Fund’s potential inability to terminate or sell its derivative positions as a liquid secondary market for such positions may not exist at times when a Fund may wish to terminate or sell them. Over-the-counter instruments (investments not traded on an exchange) may be illiquid. Derivatives traded in the over-the-counter market are subject to the risk that the other party will not meet its obligations. Also, with some derivative strategies there is the risk that a Fund may not be able to find a suitable derivative transaction counterparty, and thus may be unable to invest in derivatives altogether. The use of derivatives may also increase the amount and accelerate the timing of taxes payable by shareholders.

A Fund may use any or all of the above investment techniques and may purchase different types of derivative instruments at any time and in any combination. There is no particular strategy that dictates the use of one technique over another, as the use of derivatives is a function of numerous variables, including market conditions.

Index or Linked Securities (Structured Products)

General. Indexed or linked securities, also often referred to as “structured products,” are instruments that may have varying combinations of equity and debt characteristics. These instruments are structured to recast the investment characteristics of the underlying security or reference asset. If the issuer is a unit investment trust or other special purpose vehicle, the structuring will typically involve the deposit with or purchase by such issuer of specified instruments (such as commercial bank loans or securities) and/or the execution of various derivative transactions, and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of securities (structured securities) backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying instruments. The cash flow on the underlying instruments may be apportioned among the newly issued structured securities to create securities with different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, payment priorities and interest rate provisions, and the extent of such payments made with respect to structured securities is dependent on the extent of the cash flow on the underlying instruments.

 

22


Table of Contents

 

Indexed and Inverse Floating Rate Securities. A Fund may invest in securities that provide a potential return based on a particular index of value or interest rates. For example, a Fund may invest in securities that pay interest based on an index of interest rates. The principal amount payable upon maturity of certain securities also may be based on the value of the index. To the extent a Fund invests in these types of securities, a Fund’s return on such securities will rise and fall with the value of the particular index: that is, if the value of the index falls, the value of the indexed securities owned by a Fund will fall. Interest and principal payable on certain securities may also be based on relative changes among particular indices.

A Fund may also invest in so-called “inverse floaters” or “residual interest bonds” on which the interest rates vary inversely with a floating rate (which may be reset periodically by a dutch auction, a remarketing agent, or by reference to a short-term tax-exempt interest rate index). A Fund may purchase synthetically-created inverse floating rate bonds evidenced by custodial or trust receipts. Generally, income on inverse floating rate bonds will decrease when interest rates increase, and will increase when interest rates decrease. Such securities have the effect of providing a degree of investment leverage, since they may increase or decrease in value in response to changes, as an illustration, in market interest rates at a rate that is a multiple of the rate at which fixed-rate securities increase or decrease in response to such changes. As a result, the market values of such securities will generally be more volatile than the market values of fixed-rate securities. To seek to limit the volatility of these securities, a Fund may purchase inverse floating obligations that have shorter-term maturities or that contain limitations on the extent to which the interest rate may vary. Certain investments in such obligations may be illiquid. A Fund may invest in indexed and inverse securities for hedging purposes or to seek to increase returns. When used for hedging purposes, indexed and inverse securities involve correlation risk. Furthermore, where such a security includes a contingent liability, in the event of an adverse movement in the underlying index or interest rate, a Fund may be required to pay substantial additional margin to maintain the position.

Credit Linked Securities. Among the income producing securities in which a Fund may invest are credit linked securities. The issuers of these securities frequently are limited purpose trusts or other special purpose vehicles that, in turn, invest in a derivative instrument or basket of derivative instruments, such as credit default swaps, interest rate swaps and other securities, in order to provide exposure to certain fixed income markets. For instance, a Fund may invest in credit linked securities as a cash management tool in order to gain exposure to a certain market and/or to remain fully invested when more traditional income producing securities are not available.

Like an investment in a bond, investments in these credit linked securities represent the right to receive periodic income payments (in the form of distributions) and payment of principal at the end of the term of the security. However, these payments are conditioned on or linked to the issuer’s receipt of payments from, and the issuer’s potential obligations to, the counterparties to the derivative instruments and other securities in which the issuer invests. For instance, the issuer may sell one or more credit default swaps, under which the issuer would receive a stream of payments over the term of the swap agreements provided that no event of default has occurred with respect to the referenced debt obligation upon which the swap is based. If a default occurs, the stream of payments may stop and the issuer would be obligated to pay the counterparty the par (or other agreed upon value) of the referenced debt obligation. This, in turn, would reduce the amount of income and/or principal that a Fund would receive. A Fund’s investments in these instruments are indirectly subject to the risks associated with derivative instruments, including, among others, credit risk, default or similar event risk, counterparty risk, interest rate risk, leverage risk and management risk. These securities generally are exempt from registration under the 1933 Act. Accordingly, there may be no established trading market for the securities and they may constitute illiquid investments.

Index-, Commodity-, Currency- and Equity-Linked Securities. “Index-linked” or “commodity-linked” notes are debt securities of companies that call for interest payments and/or payment at maturity in different terms than the typical note where the borrower agrees to make fixed interest payments and to pay a fixed sum at maturity. Principal and/or interest payments on an index-linked or commodity-linked note depend on the performance of

 

23


Table of Contents

one or more market indices, such as the S&P 500® Index, a weighted index of commodity futures such as crude oil, gasoline and natural gas or the market prices of a particular commodity or basket of commodities. Equity-linked securities are short-term or intermediate term instruments having a value at maturity and/or interest rate determined by reference to the market prices of one or more equity securities. At maturity, the principal amount of an equity-linked debt security is often exchanged for common stock of the issuer or is payable in an amount based on the issuer’s common stock price at the time of maturity. Currency-linked debt securities are short-term or intermediate-term instruments having a value at maturity, and/or an interest rate, determined by reference to one or more foreign currencies. Payment of principal or periodic interest may be calculated as a multiple of the movement of one currency against another currency, or against an index.

Index, commodity, currency and equity-linked securities may entail substantial risks. Such instruments may be subject to significant price volatility. The company issuing the instrument may fail to pay the amount due on maturity. The underlying investment or security may not perform as expected by the Adviser. Markets, underlying securities and indexes may move in a direction that was not anticipated by the Adviser. Performance of the derivatives may be influenced by interest rate and other market changes in the United States and abroad, and certain derivative instruments may be illiquid.

Linked securities are often issued by unit investment trusts. Examples of this include such index-linked securities as S&P Depositary Receipts (SPDRs), which is an interest in a unit investment trust holding a portfolio of securities linked to the S&P 500® Index, and a type of exchange-traded fund (ETF). Because a unit investment trust is an investment company under the 1940 Act, a Fund’s investments in SPDRs are subject to the limitations set forth in Section 12(d)(1)(A) of the 1940 Act. SPDRs closely track the underlying portfolio of securities, trade like a share of common stock and pay periodic dividends proportionate to those paid by the portfolio of stocks that comprise the S&P 500® Index. As a holder of interests in a unit investment trust, a Fund would indirectly bear its ratable share of that unit investment trust’s expenses. At the same time, a Fund would continue to pay its own management and advisory fees and other expenses, as a result of which a Fund and its shareholders in effect would be absorbing levels of fees with respect to investments in such unit investment trusts.

Equity-linked securities include issues such as Structured Yield Product Exchangeable for Stock (STRYPES), Trust Automatic Common Exchange Securities (TRACES), Trust Issued Mandatory Exchange Securities (TIMES), and Trust Enhanced Dividend Securities (TRENDS). The issuers of these equity-linked securities generally purchase and hold a portfolio of stripped U.S. Treasury securities maturing on a quarterly basis through the conversion date, and a forward purchase contract with an existing shareholder of the company relating to the common stock. Quarterly distributions on such equity-linked securities generally consist of the cash received from the U.S. Treasury securities and such equity-linked securities generally are not entitled to any dividends that may be declared on the common stock.

Investing in structured products and linked securities is subject to certain risks. Because structured products typically involve no credit enhancement, their credit risk generally will be equivalent to that of the underlying instruments. Investments in structured products may be structured as a class that is either subordinated or unsubordinated to the right of payment of another class. Subordinated structured products typically have higher rates of return and present greater risks than unsubordinated structured products. Structured products sometimes are sold in private placement transactions and often have a limited trading market.

Investments in “linked” securities have the potential to lead to significant losses because of unexpected movements in the underlying financial asset, index, currency or other investment. The ability of a Fund to utilize linked-securities successfully will depend on its ability correctly to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. Because currency-linked securities usually relate to foreign currencies, some of which may be currencies from emerging market countries, there are certain additional risks associated with such investments.

SPDRs are subject to the risks of an investment in a broadly based portfolio of common stocks, including the risk that the general level of stock prices may decline, thereby adversely affecting the value of such

 

24


Table of Contents

investment. In addition, because individual investments in SPDRs are not redeemable, except upon termination of the unit investment trust, the liquidity of small holdings of SPDRs will depend upon the existence of a secondary market. Large holdings of SPDRs are called “creation unit size” and are redeemable in-kind only and are not redeemable for cash from the unit investment trust. The price of a SPDR is derived from and based upon the securities held by the unit investment trust. Accordingly, the level of risk involved in the purchase or sale of a SPDR is similar to the risk involved in the purchase or sale of traditional common stock, with the exception that the pricing mechanism for SPDRs is based on a basket of stocks. Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying SPDRs purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on SPDRs.

Futures Contracts and Options on Futures Contracts

Futures Contracts. A futures contract sale creates an obligation by the seller to deliver the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. A futures contract purchase creates an obligation by the purchaser to take delivery of the type of security or other asset called for in the contract at a specified delivery time for a stated price. The specific security or other asset delivered or taken at the settlement date is not determined until on or near that date. The determination is made in accordance with the rules of the exchange on which the futures contract was made. A Fund may enter into futures contracts which are traded on national or foreign futures exchanges and are standardized as to maturity date and underlying security or other asset. Futures exchanges and trading in the United States are regulated under the Commodity Exchange Act (CEA) by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), a U.S. Government agency.

Traders in futures contracts may be broadly classified as either “hedgers” or “speculators.” Hedgers use the futures markets primarily to offset unfavorable changes (anticipated or potential) in the value of securities or other assets currently owned or expected to be acquired by them. Speculators less often own the securities or other assets underlying the futures contracts which they trade, and generally use futures contracts with the expectation of realizing profits from fluctuations in the value of the underlying securities or other assets. Pursuant to a notice of eligibility claiming exclusion from the definition of commodity pool operator filed with the CFTC and the National Futures Association on behalf of the Funds, neither the Trust nor any of the individual Funds is deemed to be a “commodity pool operator” under the CEA, and, accordingly, they are not subject to registration or regulation as such under the CEA.

Upon entering into futures contracts, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities, equal in value to the amount of a Fund’s obligation under the contract (less any applicable margin deposits and any assets that constitute “cover” for such obligation), will be segregated with a Fund’s custodian.

Unlike when a Fund purchases or sells a security, no price is paid or received by a Fund upon the purchase or sale of a futures contract, although a Fund is required to deposit with its custodian in a segregated account in the name of the futures broker an amount of cash and/or U.S. Government securities in order to initiate and maintain open positions in futures contracts. This amount is known as “initial margin.” The nature of initial margin in futures transactions is different from that of margin in security transactions, in that futures contract margin does not involve the borrowing of funds by a Fund to finance the transactions. Rather, initial margin is in the nature of a performance bond or good faith deposit intended to assure completion of the contract (delivery or acceptance of the underlying security or other asset) that is returned to a Fund upon termination of the futures contract, assuming all contractual obligations have been satisfied. Minimum initial margin requirements are established by the relevant futures exchange and may be changed. Brokers may establish deposit requirements which are higher than the exchange minimums. Futures contracts are customarily purchased and sold on margin which may range upward from less than 5% of the value of the contract being traded. Subsequent payments, called “variation margin,” to and from the broker (or the custodian) are made on a daily basis as the price of the underlying security or other asset fluctuates, a process known as “marking to market.” If the futures contract price changes to the extent that the margin on deposit does not satisfy margin requirements, payment of additional variation margin will be required. Conversely, a change in the contract value may reduce the required margin, resulting in a repayment of excess margin to the contract holder. Variation margin payments are made for as long as the contract remains open. A Fund expects to earn interest income on its margin deposits.

 

25


Table of Contents

 

Although futures contracts by their terms call for actual delivery or acceptance of securities or other assets (stock index futures contracts or futures contracts that reference other intangible assets do not permit delivery of the referenced assets), the contracts usually are closed out before the settlement date without the making or taking of delivery. A Fund may elect to close some or all of its futures positions at any time prior to their expiration. The purpose of taking such action would be to reduce or eliminate the position then currently held by a Fund. Closing out an open futures position is done by taking an opposite position (“buying” a contract which has previously been “sold,” “selling” a contract previously “purchased”) in an identical contract (i.e., the same aggregate amount of the specific type of security or other asset with the same delivery date) to terminate the position. Final determinations are made as to whether the price of the initial sale of the futures contract exceeds or is below the price of the offsetting purchase, or whether the purchase price exceeds or is below the offsetting sale price. Final determinations of variation margin are then made, additional cash is required to be paid by or released to a Fund, and a Fund realizes a loss or a gain. Brokerage commissions are incurred when a futures contract is bought or sold.

Successful use of futures contracts by a Fund is subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of interest rates and other factors affecting securities and commodities markets. This requires different skills and techniques than those required to predict changes in the prices of individual securities. A Fund, therefore, bears the risk that future market trends will be incorrectly predicted.

The risk of loss in trading futures contracts in some strategies can be substantial, due both to the relatively low margin deposits required and the potential for an extremely high degree of leverage involved in futures contracts. As a result, a relatively small price movement in a futures contract may result in an immediate and substantial loss to the investor. For example, if at the time of purchase, 10% of the value of the futures contract is deposited as margin, a subsequent 10% decrease in the value of the futures contract would result in a total loss of the margin deposit, before any deduction for the transaction costs, if the account were then closed out. A 15% decrease would result in a loss equal to 150% of the original margin deposit if the contract were closed out. Thus, a purchase or sale of a futures contract may result in losses in excess of the amount posted as initial margin for the contract.

In the event of adverse price movements, a Fund would continue to be required to make daily cash payments in order to maintain its required margin. In such a situation, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell portfolio securities in order to meet daily margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. The inability to close the futures position also could have an adverse impact on the ability to hedge effectively.

To reduce or eliminate a hedge position held by a Fund, a Fund may seek to close out a position. The ability to establish and close out positions will be subject to the development and maintenance of a liquid secondary market. It is not certain that this market will develop or continue to exist for a particular futures contract, which may limit a Fund’s ability to realize its profits or limit its losses. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain contracts; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions, closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of contracts, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of contracts (or a particular class or series of contracts), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of contracts) would cease to exist, although outstanding contracts on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

 

26


Table of Contents

 

Interest Rate Futures Contracts. Bond prices are established in both the cash market and the futures market. In the cash market, bonds are purchased and sold with payment for the full purchase price of the bond being made in cash, generally within five business days after the trade. In the futures market, a contract is made to purchase or sell a bond in the future for a set price on a certain date. Historically, the prices for bonds established in the futures markets have tended to move generally in the aggregate in concert with the cash market prices and have maintained fairly predictable relationships. Accordingly, a Fund may use interest rate futures contracts as a defense, or hedge, against anticipated interest rate changes. A Fund presently could accomplish a similar result to that which it hopes to achieve through the use of interest rate futures contracts by selling bonds with long maturities and investing in bonds with short maturities when interest rates are expected to increase, or conversely, selling bonds with short maturities and investing in bonds with long maturities when interest rates are expected to decline. However, because of the liquidity that is often available in the futures market, the protection is more likely to be achieved, perhaps at a lower cost and without changing the rate of interest being earned by a Fund, through using futures contracts.

Interest rate futures contracts are traded in an auction environment on the floors of several exchanges principally, the Chicago Board of Trade, the Chicago Mercantile Exchange and the New York Futures Exchange. Each exchange guarantees performance under contract provisions through a clearing corporation, a nonprofit organization managed by the exchange membership. A public market exists in futures contracts covering various financial instruments including long-term U.S. Treasury Bonds and Notes; GNMA modified pass-through mortgage backed securities; three-month U.S. Treasury Bills; and ninety-day commercial paper. A Fund may also invest in exchange-traded Eurodollar contracts, which are interest rate futures on the forward level of LIBOR. These contracts are generally considered liquid securities and trade on the Chicago Mercantile Exchange. Such Eurodollar contracts are generally used to “lock-in” or hedge the future level of short-term rates. A Fund may trade in any interest rate futures contracts for which there exists a public market, including, without limitation, the foregoing instruments.

Index Futures Contracts. An index futures contract is a contract to buy or sell units of an index at a specified future date at a price agreed upon when the contract is made. Entering into a contract to buy units of an index is commonly referred to as buying or purchasing a contract or holding a long position in the index. Entering into a contract to sell units of an index is commonly referred to as selling a contract or holding a short position in the index. A unit is the current value of the index. A Fund may enter into stock index futures contracts, debt index futures contracts, or other index futures contracts appropriate to its objective(s).

There are several risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. One risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged.

Municipal Bond Index Futures Contracts. Municipal bond index futures contracts may act as a hedge against changes in market conditions. A municipal bond index assigns values daily to the municipal bonds included in the index based on the independent assessment of dealer-to-dealer municipal bond brokers. A municipal bond index futures contract represents a firm commitment by which two parties agree to take or make delivery of an amount equal to a specified dollar amount multiplied by the difference between the municipal bond index value on the last trading date of the contract and the price at which the futures contract is originally struck. No physical delivery of the underlying securities in the index is made.

Options on Futures Contracts. A Fund may purchase and write call and put options on those futures contracts that it is permitted to buy or sell. A Fund may use such options on futures contracts in lieu of writing options directly on the underlying securities or other assets or purchasing and selling the underlying futures contracts. Such options generally operate in the same manner as options purchased or written directly on the underlying investments. A futures option gives the holder, in return for the premium paid, the right to buy from

 

27


Table of Contents

(call) or sell to (put) the writer of the option a futures contract at a specified price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise, the writer of the option is obligated to pay the difference between the cash value of the futures contract and the exercise price. Like the buyer or seller of a futures contract, the holder or writer of an option has the right to terminate its position prior to the scheduled expiration of the option by selling or purchasing an option of the same series, at which time the person entering into the closing purchase transaction will realize a gain or loss. There is no guarantee that such closing purchase transactions can be effected.

A Fund will enter into written options on futures contracts only when, in compliance with the SEC’s requirements, cash or liquid securities equal in value to the underlying security’s or other asset’s value (less any applicable margin deposits) have been deposited in a segregated account. A Fund will be required to deposit initial margin and maintenance margin with respect to put and call options on futures contracts written by it pursuant to brokers’ requirements similar to those described above.

Investments in futures options involve some of the same risks that are involved in connection with investments in futures contracts (for example, the existence of a liquid secondary market). In addition, the purchase of an option also entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option purchased. There may be circumstances when the purchase of a call or put option on a futures contract would result in a loss to a Fund when the purchase or sale of a futures contract would not, such as when there is no movement in the prices of the hedged investments. In general, the market prices of options can be expected to be more volatile than the market prices on the underlying futures contracts. Compared to the purchase or sale of futures contracts, however, the purchase of call or put options on futures contracts may frequently involve less potential risk to a Fund because the maximum amount at risk is the premium paid for the options (plus transaction costs).

Successful use of index futures by a Fund is also subject to the Adviser’s ability to predict correctly movements in the direction of the market. It is possible that, for example, where a Fund has sold futures to hedge its portfolio against a decline in the market, the index on which the futures are written may advance and the value of securities held in a Fund’s portfolio may decline. If this occurred, a Fund would lose money on the futures and also experience a decline in the value of its portfolio securities, as a Fund’s ability to effectively hedge all or a portion of the securities in its portfolio, in anticipation of or during a market decline, through transactions in futures or put options on stock indices, depends on the degree to which price movements in the underlying index correlate with the price movements of the securities held by a Fund. Inasmuch as a Fund’s securities will not duplicate the components of an index, the correlation will not be perfect. Consequently, a Fund bears the risk that the prices of its securities being hedged will not move to the same extent as do the prices of its put options on the stock indices. It is also possible that, if a Fund has hedged against the possibility of a decline in the market adversely affecting securities held in its portfolio and securities prices increase instead, a Fund will lose part or all of the benefit of the increased values of those securities that it has hedged, because it will have offsetting losses in its futures positions. In addition, in such situations, if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to sell securities to meet daily variation margin requirements.

In addition to the possibility that there may be an imperfect correlation, or no correlation at all, between movements in the index futures and the securities of the portfolio being hedged, the prices of index futures may not correlate perfectly with movements in the underlying index due to certain market distortions. First, all participants in the futures markets are subject to margin deposit and maintenance requirements. Rather than meeting additional margin deposit requirements, investors may close futures contracts through offsetting transactions, which would distort the normal relationship between the index and futures markets. Second, margin requirements in the futures market are less onerous than margin requirements in the securities market, and as a result, the futures market may attract more speculators than the securities market. Increased participation by speculators in the futures market may also cause temporary price distortions. Due to the possibility of price distortions in the futures market, and also because of the imperfect correlation between movements in an index and movements in the prices of index futures, even a correct forecast of general market trends by the Adviser may still not result in a successful hedging transaction.

 

28


Table of Contents

 

There is also the risk of loss by a Fund of margin deposits in the event of bankruptcy of a broker with whom a Fund has an open position in a futures contract or related option. Most futures exchanges limit the amount of fluctuation permitted in some contract prices during a single trading day. The daily limit establishes the maximum amount that the price of a futures contract may vary either up or down from the previous day’s settlement price at the end of a trading session. Once the daily limit has been reached in a particular type of contract, no trades may be made on that day at a price beyond that limit. The daily limit governs only price movement during a particular trading day and, therefore, does not limit potential losses, because the limit may prevent the liquidation of unfavorable positions. Futures contract prices have occasionally moved to the daily limit for several consecutive trading days with little or no trading, thereby preventing prompt liquidation of futures positions and subjecting some futures traders to substantial losses.

Options on Index Futures Contracts. A Fund may also purchase and sell options on index futures contracts. Options on index futures give the purchaser the right, in return for the premium paid, to assume a position in an index futures contract (a long position if the option is a call and a short position if the option is a put), at a specified exercise price at any time during the period of the option. Upon exercise of the option, the delivery of the futures position by the writer of the option to the holder of the option will be accompanied by delivery of the accumulated balance in the writer’s futures margin account, which represents the amount by which the market price of the index futures contract, at exercise, exceeds (in the case of a call) or is less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option on the index future. If an option is exercised on the last trading day prior to the expiration date of the option, the settlement will be made entirely in cash equal to the difference between the exercise price of the option and the closing level of the index on which the future is based on the expiration date. Purchasers of options who fail to exercise their options prior to the exercise date suffer a loss of the premium paid.

There are various risks in connection with the use by a Fund of index futures as a hedging device. For example, a risk arises because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of the index futures and movements in the prices of securities which are the subject of the hedges. The Adviser will attempt to reduce this risk by selling, to the extent possible, futures on indices the movements of which will, in its judgment, have a significant correlation with movements in the prices of a Fund’s portfolio securities sought to be hedged; there can be no assurance that the Adviser will be successful in doing so.

Use by Tax-Exempt Funds of Interest Rate and U.S. Treasury Security Futures Contracts and Options. If a Fund invests in tax-exempt securities, it may purchase and sell futures contracts and related options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities when, in the opinion of the Adviser, price movements in these security futures and related options will correlate closely with price movements in the tax-exempt securities which are the subject of the hedge. Interest rate and U.S. Treasury securities futures contracts require the seller to deliver, or the purchaser to take delivery of, the type of security called for in the contract at a specified date and price. Options on interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts give the purchaser the right in return for the premium paid to assume a position in a futures contract at the specified option exercise price at any time during the period of the option.

In addition to the risks generally involved in using futures contracts, there is also a risk that price movements in interest rate and U.S. Treasury security futures contracts and related options will not correlate closely with price movements in markets for tax-exempt securities.

Stock Options and Stock Index Options

A Fund may purchase and write (i.e., sell) put and call options. Such options may relate to particular stocks or stock indices, and may or may not be listed on a domestic or foreign securities exchange and may or may not be issued by the Options Clearing Corporation (OCC). Stock index options are put options and call options on various stock indices. In most respects, they are identical to listed options on common stocks.

 

29


Table of Contents

 

There is a key difference between stock options and stock index options in connection with their exercise. In the case of stock options, the underlying security, common stock, is delivered. However, upon the exercise of an index option, settlement does not occur by delivery of the securities comprising the index. The option holder who exercises the index option receives an amount of cash if the closing level of the stock index upon which the option is based is greater than (in the case of a call) or less than (in the case of a put) the exercise price of the option. This amount of cash is equal to the difference between the closing price of the stock index and the exercise price of the option expressed in dollars times a specified multiple. A stock index fluctuates with changes in the market value of the securities included in the index. For example, some stock index options are based on a broad market index, such as the S&P 500® Index or a narrower market index, such as the S&P 100® Index. Indices may also be based on an industry or market segment.

The successful use of a Fund’s options strategies depends on the ability of the Adviser to forecast interest rate and market movements correctly. When it purchases an option, a Fund runs the risk that it will lose its entire investment in the option in a relatively short period of time, unless a Fund exercises the option or enters into a closing sale transaction for such option during the life of the option. If the price of the underlying security does not rise (in the case of a call) or fall (in the case of a put) to an extent sufficient to cover the option premium and transaction costs, a Fund will lose part or all of its investment in the option. This contrasts with an investment by a Fund in the underlying securities, since a Fund may continue to hold its investment in those securities notwithstanding the lack of a change in price of those securities.

The effective use of options also depends on a Fund’s ability to terminate option positions at times when the Adviser deems it desirable to do so. Although a Fund will take an option position only if the Adviser believes there is a liquid secondary market for the option, there is no assurance that a Fund will be able to effect closing transactions at any particular time or at an acceptable price.

If a secondary trading market in options were to become unavailable, a Fund could no longer engage in closing transactions. The writer in such circumstances would be subject to the risk of market decline or appreciation in the instrument during such period. If an option purchased by a Fund expires unexercised, a Fund will realize a loss equal to the premium paid. Reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an exchange include the following: (i) there may be insufficient trading interest in certain options; (ii) restrictions may be imposed by an exchange on opening transactions or closing transactions or both; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of options, or underlying securities; (iv) unusual or unforeseen circumstances, such as volume in excess of trading or clearing capability, may interrupt normal operations on an exchange; (v) the facilities of an exchange or a clearing corporation may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or (vi) one or more exchanges could, for economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series of options), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in the class or series of options) would cease to exist, although outstanding options on the exchange that had been issued by a clearing corporation as a result of trades on that exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.

Disruptions in the markets for the securities underlying options purchased or sold by a Fund could result in losses on the options. If trading is interrupted in an underlying security, the trading of options on that security is normally halted as well. As a result, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be unable to close out its positions until options trading resumes, and it may be faced with losses if trading in the security reopens at a substantially different price. In addition, the OCC or other options markets may impose exercise restrictions. If a prohibition on exercise is imposed at a time when trading in the option has also been halted, a Fund as purchaser or writer of an option will be locked into its position until one of the two restrictions has been lifted. If a prohibition on exercise remains in effect until an option owned by a Fund has expired, a Fund could lose the entire value of its option.

 

30


Table of Contents

 

Special risks are presented by internationally traded options. Because of time differences between the United States and various foreign countries, and because different holidays are observed in different countries, foreign options markets may be open for trading during hours or on days when U.S. markets are closed. As a result, option premiums may not reflect the current prices of the underlying interest in the United States.

Dealer (Over-the-Counter) Options. Dealer options are options negotiated individually through dealers rather than traded on an exchange. Certain risks are specific to dealer options. While a Fund might look to a clearing corporation to exercise exchange-traded options, if a Fund purchases a dealer option it must rely on the selling dealer to perform if a Fund exercises the option. Failure by the dealer to do so would result in the loss of the premium paid by a Fund as well as loss of the expected benefit of the transaction. Exchange-traded options generally have a continuous liquid market while dealer options more often may not. Consequently, a Fund can realize the value of a dealer option it has purchased only by exercising or reselling the option to the issuing dealer. Similarly, when a Fund writes a dealer option, a Fund can close out the option prior to its expiration only by entering into a closing purchase transaction with the dealer. While each Fund seeks to enter into dealer options only with dealers who will agree to and can enter into closing transactions with a Fund, no assurance exists that a Fund will at any time be able to liquidate a dealer option at a favorable price at any time prior to expiration. Unless a Fund, as a covered dealer call option writer, can effect a closing purchase transaction, it will not be able to liquidate securities (or other assets) used as cover until the option expires or is exercised. In the event of insolvency of the other party, a Fund may be unable to liquidate a dealer option. With respect to options written by a Fund, the inability to enter into a closing transaction may result in material losses to a Fund. For example, because a Fund must maintain a secured position with respect to any call option on a security it writes, a Fund may not sell the assets, that it has segregated to secure the position while it is obligated under the option. This requirement may impair a Fund’s ability to sell portfolio securities at a time when such sale might be advantageous.

A Fund generally will treat purchased dealer options as illiquid securities. A Fund may treat the cover used for written dealer options as liquid if the dealer agrees that a Fund may repurchase the dealer option it has written for a maximum price to be calculated by a predetermined formula. In such cases, the dealer option would be considered illiquid only to the extent the maximum purchase price under the formula exceeds the intrinsic value of the option.

Writing Covered Options. A Fund may write covered call options and covered put options on securities held in its portfolio when, in the opinion of the Adviser, such transactions are consistent with a Fund’s investment goal and policies. Call options written by a Fund give the purchaser the right to buy the underlying securities from a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price; put options give the purchaser the right to sell the underlying securities to a Fund at the stated exercise price at any time prior to the expiration date of the option, regardless of the security’s market price.

A Fund may write only covered options, which means that, so long as a Fund is obligated as the writer of a call option, it will own the underlying securities subject to the option (or comparable securities satisfying the cover requirements of securities exchanges). In the case of put options, a Fund will hold cash and/or high-grade short-term debt obligations equal to the price to be paid if the option is exercised. In addition, a Fund will be considered to have covered a put or call option if and to the extent that it holds an option that offsets some or all of the risk of the option it has written. A Fund may write combinations of covered puts and calls (straddles) on the same underlying security.

A Fund will receive a premium from writing a put or call option, which increases a Fund’s return on the underlying security if the option expires unexercised or is closed out at a profit. The amount of the premium reflects, among other things, the relationship between the exercise price and the current market value of the underlying security, the volatility of the underlying security, the amount of time remaining until expiration, current interest rates, and the effect of supply and demand in the options market and in the market for the

 

31


Table of Contents

underlying security. By writing a call option, a Fund limits its opportunity to profit from any increase in the market value of the underlying security above the exercise price of the option but continues to bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security. By writing a put option, a Fund assumes the risk that it may be required to purchase the underlying security for an exercise price higher than the security’s then-current market value, resulting in a potential capital loss unless the security subsequently appreciates in value.

A Fund’s obligation to sell an instrument subject to a call option written by it, or to purchase an instrument subject to a put option written by it, may be terminated prior to the expiration date of the option by a Fund’s execution of a closing purchase transaction, which is effected by purchasing on an exchange an offsetting option of the same series (i.e., same underlying instrument, exercise price and expiration date) as the option previously written. A closing purchase transaction will ordinarily be effected in order to realize a profit on an outstanding option, to prevent an underlying instrument from being called, to permit the sale of the underlying instrument or to permit the writing of a new option containing different terms on such underlying instrument. A Fund realizes a profit or loss from a closing purchase transaction if the cost of the transaction (option premium plus transaction costs) is less or more than the premium received from writing the option. Because increases in the market price of a call option generally reflect increases in the market price of the security underlying the option, any loss resulting from a closing purchase transaction may be offset in whole or in part by unrealized appreciation of the underlying security.

If a Fund writes a call option but does not own the underlying security, and when it writes a put option, a Fund may be required to deposit cash or securities with its broker as “margin” or collateral for its obligation to buy or sell the underlying security. As the value of the underlying security varies, a Fund may also have to deposit additional margin with the broker. Margin requirements are complex and are fixed by individual brokers, subject to minimum requirements currently imposed by the Federal Reserve Board and by stock exchanges and other self-regulatory organizations.

Purchasing Put Options. A Fund may purchase put options to protect its portfolio holdings in an underlying security against a decline in market value. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the put option since a Fund, as holder of the put option, is able to sell the underlying security at the put exercise price regardless of any decline in the underlying security’s market price. For a put option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must decline sufficiently below the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. By using put options in this manner, a Fund will reduce any profit it might otherwise have realized from appreciation of the underlying security by the premium paid for the put option and by transaction costs.

Purchasing Call Options. A Fund may purchase call options to hedge against an increase in the price of securities that a Fund wants ultimately to buy. Such hedge protection is provided during the life of the call option since a Fund, as holder of the call option, is able to buy the underlying security at the exercise price regardless of any increase in the underlying security’s market price. In order for a call option to be profitable, the market price of the underlying security must rise sufficiently above the exercise price to cover the premium and transaction costs. These costs will reduce any profit a Fund might have realized had it bought the underlying security at the time it purchased the call option.

Over-the-Counter (OTC) Options. A Fund will enter into OTC options transactions only with primary dealers in U.S. Government securities and, in the case of OTC options written by a Fund, only pursuant to agreements that will assure that a Fund will at all times have the right to repurchase the option written by it from the dealer at a specified formula price. A Fund will treat the amount by which such formula price exceeds the amount, if any, by which the option may be “in-the-money” as an illiquid investment. It is the present policy of a Fund not to enter into any OTC option transaction if, as a result, more than 15% (10% in some cases, refer to your Fund’s prospectuses) of a Fund’s net assets would be invested in (i) illiquid investments (determined under the foregoing formula) relating to OTC options written by a Fund, (ii) OTC options purchased by a Fund, (iii) securities which are not readily marketable, and (iv) repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days.

 

32


Table of Contents

 

Index Options. As an alternative to purchasing call and put options on index futures, a Fund may purchase call and put options on the underlying indices themselves. Such options could be used in a manner identical to the use of options on index futures. Options involving securities indices provide the holder with the right to make or receive a cash settlement upon exercise of the option based on movements in the relevant index. Such options must be listed on a national securities exchange and issued by the OCC. Such options may relate to particular securities or to various stock indices, except that a Fund may not write covered options on an index.

Foreign Stock Index Options. A Fund may, for the purpose of hedging its portfolio, subject to applicable securities regulations, purchase and write put and call options on foreign stock indices listed on foreign and domestic stock exchanges.

Swap Agreements

Swap agreements are derivative instruments that can be individually negotiated and structured to include exposure to a variety of different types of investments or market factors. Depending on their structure, swap agreements may increase or decrease a Fund’s exposure to long- or short-term interest rates, foreign currency values, mortgage securities, corporate borrowing rates, or other factors such as security prices or inflation rates. A Fund may enter into a variety of swap agreements, including interest rate, index, commodity, equity, credit default and currency exchange rate swap agreements, and other types of swap agreements such as caps, collars and floors. A Fund also may enter into swaptions, which are options to enter into a swap agreement.

In a typical interest rate swap, one party agrees to make regular payments equal to a floating interest rate times a “notional principal amount,” in return for payments equal to a fixed rate times the same amount, for a specified period of time. If a swap agreement provides for payments in different currencies, the parties might agree to exchange notional principal amount as well. In a total return swap agreement, the non-floating rate side of the swap is based on the total return of an individual security, a basket of securities, an index or another reference asset. Swaps may also depend on other prices or rates, such as the value of an index or mortgage prepayment rates.

In a typical cap or floor agreement, one party agrees to make payments only under specified circumstances, usually in return for payment of a fee by the other party. For example, the buyer of an interest rate cap obtains the right to receive payments to the extent that a specified interest rate exceeds an agreed-upon level, while the seller of an interest rate floor is obligated to make payments to the extent that a specified interest rate falls below an agreed-upon level. Caps and floors have an effect similar to buying or writing options. A collar combines elements of buying a cap and selling a floor.

Swap agreements will tend to shift a Fund’s investment exposure from one type of investment to another. For example, if a Fund agreed to pay fixed rates in exchange for floating rates while holding fixed-rate bonds, the swap would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to long-term interest rates. Another example is if a Fund agreed to exchange payments in dollars for payments in foreign currency, the swap agreement would tend to decrease a Fund’s exposure to U.S. interest rates and increase its exposure to foreign currency and interest rates.

Swap agreements are sophisticated hedging instruments that typically involve a small investment of cash relative to the magnitude of risks assumed. As a result, swaps can be highly volatile and may have a considerable impact on a Fund’s performance. Depending on how they are used, swap agreements may increase or decrease the overall volatility of a Fund’s investments and its share price and yield. Additionally, whether a Fund’s use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment objective will depend on the Adviser’s ability correctly to predict whether certain types of investments likely are to produce greater returns than other investments. Because they are two party contracts and because they may have terms of greater than seven days, swap agreements may be considered to be illiquid. Moreover, a Fund bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. The most significant factor in the performance of swap agreements is the change in the specific

 

33


Table of Contents

interest rate, currency, or other factor that determines the amounts of payments due to and from a Fund. If a swap agreement calls for payments by a Fund, a Fund must be prepared to make such payments when due. In addition, if the counterparty’s creditworthiness declines, the value of a swap agreement likely would decline, potentially resulting in losses for a Fund. A Fund will closely monitor the credit of a swap agreement counterparty in order to attempt to minimize this risk. A Fund may also suffer losses if it is unable to terminate outstanding swap agreements (either by assignment or other disposition) or reduce its exposure through offsetting transactions (i.e., by entering into an offsetting swap agreement with the same party or a similarly creditworthy party).

Credit Default Swap Agreements. A Fund may enter into credit default swap agreements, which may have as reference obligations one or more securities or a basket of securities that are or are not currently held by a Fund. The protection “buyer” in a credit default contract is generally obligated to pay the protection “seller” an upfront or a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract provided that no credit event, such as a default, on a reference obligation has occurred. If a credit event occurs, the seller generally must pay the buyer the “par value” (full notional value) of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity described in the swap, or the seller may be required to deliver the related net cash amount, if the swap is cash settled. A Fund may be either the buyer or seller in the transaction. If a Fund is a buyer and no credit event occurs, a Fund may recover nothing if the swap is held through its termination date. However, if a credit event occurs, the buyer generally may elect to receive the full notional value of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity whose value may have significantly decreased. As a seller, a Fund generally receives an upfront payment or a fixed rate of income throughout the term of the swap provided that there is no credit event. As the seller, a Fund would effectively add leverage to its portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Credit default swap agreements may involve greater risks than if a Fund had invested in the reference obligation directly since, in addition to risks relating to the reference obligation, credit default swaps are subject to illiquidity risk, counterparty risk and credit risk. A Fund will enter into credit default swap agreements generally with counterparties that meet certain standards of creditworthiness. A buyer generally will lose its investment and recover nothing if no credit event occurs and the swap is held to its termination date. If a credit event were to occur, the value of any deliverable obligation received by the seller, coupled with the upfront or periodic payments previously received, may be less than the full notional value it pays to the buyer, resulting in a loss of value to the seller.

Equity Swaps. A Fund may engage in equity swaps. Equity swaps allow the parties to the swap agreement to exchange components of return on one equity investment (e.g., a basket of equity securities or an index) for a component of return on another non-equity or equity investment, including an exchange of differential rates of return. Equity swaps may be used to invest in a market without owning or taking physical custody of securities in circumstances where direct investment may be restricted for legal reasons or is otherwise impractical. Equity swaps also may be used for other purposes, such as hedging or seeking to increase total return.

The values of equity swaps can be very volatile. To the extent that the Adviser does not accurately analyze and predict the potential relative fluctuation on the components swapped with the other party, a Fund may suffer a loss. The value of some components of an equity swap (such as the dividend on a common stock) may also be sensitive to changes in interest rates. Furthermore, during the period a swap is outstanding, a Fund may suffer a loss if the counterparty defaults.

Total Return Swap Agreements. Total return swap agreements are contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in market value of the assets underlying the contract, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or securities indices during the specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate or the total return from other underlying assets. Total return swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Total return swap

 

34


Table of Contents

agreements may effectively add leverage to a Fund’s portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.

Total return swap agreements are subject to the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations to a Fund thereunder, and conversely, that a Fund will not be able to meet its obligation to the counterparty. Generally, a Fund will enter into total return swaps on a net basis (i.e., the two payment streams are netted against one another with a Fund receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments). The net amount of the excess, if any, of a Fund’s obligations over its entitlements with respect to each total return swap will be accrued on a daily basis, and an amount of liquid assets having an aggregate net asset value at least equal to the accrued excess will be segregated by a Fund. If the total return swap transaction is entered into on other than a net basis, the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be accrued on a daily basis, and the full amount of a Fund’s obligations will be segregated by a Fund in an amount equal to or greater than the market value of the liabilities under the total return swap agreement or the amount it would have cost a Fund initially to make an equivalent direct investment, plus or minus any amount a Fund is obligated to pay or is to receive under the total return swap agreement.

Variance, Volatility and Correlation Swap Agreements. Variance and volatility swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the volatility of certain referenced assets. Correlation swaps are contracts that provide exposure to increases or decreases in the correlation between the prices of different assets or different market rates.

Dollar Rolls

Dollar rolls involve selling securities (e.g., mortgage-backed securities or U.S. Treasury securities) and simultaneously entering into a commitment to purchase those or similar (same collateral type, coupon and maturity) securities on a specified future date and price. Mortgage dollar rolls and U.S. Treasury rolls are types of dollar rolls. A Fund foregoes principal and interest paid on the securities during the “roll” period. A Fund is compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the lower forward price for the future purchase of the securities as well as the interest earned on the cash proceeds of the initial sale.

Dollar rolls involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase may decline below the repurchase price or that the transaction costs may exceed the return earned by a Fund from the transaction. Dollar rolls also involve risk to a Fund if the other party should default on its obligation and a Fund is delayed or prevented from completing the transaction. In the event that the buyer of securities under a dollar roll files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the dollar roll may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, the security to be delivered in the future may turn out to be inferior to the security sold upon entering into the transaction.

Foreign Currency Transactions

Foreign currency transactions may be used to protect, to some extent, against uncertainty in the level of future currency exchange rates by establishing a fixed exchange rate. Foreign currency transactions may involve the purchase or sale of foreign currencies on a “spot” (cash) basis at the prevailing exchange rate or may involve “forward contracts” that allow a Fund to purchase or sell foreign currencies at a future date. Forward contracts may be used for “transaction hedging,” “position hedging” and “cross-hedging.” A Fund may use forward sale contracts to sell an amount of a foreign currency approximating the value of a Fund’s securities denominated in the foreign security when that foreign currency suffers a substantial decline against the U.S. dollar. A Fund may use forward purchase contracts to purchase a foreign currency when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a substantial decline against the foreign currency. Although these transactions tend to minimize the risk of loss due to a decline in the value of the hedged currency, they also tend to limit any potential gain that might be realized if the value of the hedged currency increases.

 

35


Table of Contents

 

Transaction hedging may allow a Fund to “lock in” the U.S. dollar price of a security it has agreed to purchase or sell, or the U.S. dollar equivalent of a dividend or interest rate payment in a foreign currency. A Fund may use transaction hedging to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currency during the period between the date on which the security is purchased or sold, or on which the dividend or interest payment is declared, and the date on which such payments are made or received.

Position hedging may allow a Fund to protect against an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the applicable foreign currencies in which its portfolio securities are denominated. A Fund may use position hedging when it is believed that the U.S. dollar may suffer a decline against the foreign currency by entering into a forward purchase contract to purchase that foreign currency for a fixed dollar amount.

Cross-hedging may allow a Fund to enter into a forward contract to sell a different foreign currency for a fixed U.S. dollar amount when it is believed that the U.S. dollar value of the currency to be sold pursuant to the forward contract will fall if there is a decline in the U.S. dollar value of the currency in which a Fund’s securities are denominated.

A Fund also may purchase exchange-listed and over-the-counter call and put options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts. Options on foreign currencies and foreign currency contracts give the holder a right to buy or sell the underlying foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts for a specified period of time and for a specified amount. The value of an option on foreign currencies or foreign currency contracts reflects the value of an exchange rate, which depends on the relative values of the U.S. dollar and the relevant foreign currency.

Engaging in foreign currency transactions is subject to certain risks. For example, if the value of a foreign currency were to decline against the U.S. dollar, such decline would reduce the dollar value of any securities held by a Fund denominated in that currency. It is impossible to forecast with precision the market value of portfolio securities at the expiration or maturity of a forward or futures contract, which may make it necessary for a Fund to purchase additional foreign currency on the spot market if the market value of the security being hedged is less than the amount of foreign currency a Fund is obligated to deliver at the time a Fund sells the security being hedged. The value of any currency, including the U.S. dollar, may be affected by political and economic factors applicable to the issuer’s country. The exchange rates of currencies also may be affected adversely by governmental actions. Transaction, position and cross-hedging do not eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of securities that a Fund owns or intends to purchase or sell and may limit the amount of potential gain that might result from the increase in value of the currency being hedged. Settlement procedures relating to a Fund’s foreign currency transactions may be more complex than those relating to investments in securities of U.S. issuers.

Foreign Securities

Foreign securities include debt, equity and derivative securities that the Adviser determines are “foreign” based on the consideration of an issuer’s domicile, its principal place of business, its primary stock exchange listing, the source of its revenue or other factors. Foreign securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Foreign securities may include depositary receipts, such as American Depositary Receipts (ADRs), European Depositary Receipts (EDRs) and Global Depositary Receipts (GDRs). ADRs are U.S. dollar denominated receipts issued in registered form by a domestic bank or trust company that evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by a foreign issuer. EDRs are foreign currency-denominated receipts issued in

 

36


Table of Contents

Europe, typically by foreign banks or trust companies and foreign branches of domestic banks, that evidence ownership of foreign or domestic securities. GDRs are receipts structured similarly to ADRs and EDRs and are marketed globally. Depositary receipts will not necessarily be denominated in the same currency as their underlying securities. In general, ADRs, in registered form, are designed for use in the U.S. securities markets, and EDRs, in bearer form, are designed for use in European securities markets. GDRs are tradable both in the United States and in Europe and are designed for use throughout the world. A Fund may invest in depositary receipts through “sponsored” or “unsponsored” facilities. A sponsored facility is established jointly by the issuer of the underlying security and a depositary, whereas a depositary may establish an unsponsored facility without participation by the issuer of the deposited security. Holders of unsponsored depositary receipts generally bear all the costs of such facilities and the depositary of an unsponsored facility frequently is under no obligation to distribute interest holder communications received from the issuer of the deposited security or to pass through voting rights to the holders of such receipts in respect of the deposited securities. The issuers of unsponsored depositary receipts are not obligated to disclose material information in the United States, and, therefore, there may be limited information available regarding such issuers and/or limited correlation between available information and the market value of the depositary receipts.

Due to the potential for foreign withholding taxes, Morgan Stanley Capital International (MSCI) publishes two versions of its indices reflecting the reinvestment of dividends using two different methodologies: gross dividends and net dividends. While both versions reflect reinvested dividends, they differ with respect to the manner in which taxes associated with dividend payments are treated. In calculating the net dividends version, MSCI incorporates reinvested dividends applying the withholding tax rate applicable to foreign non-resident institutional investors that do not benefit from double taxation treaties. The Adviser believes that the net dividends version of MSCI indices better reflects the returns U.S. investors might expect were they to invest directly in the component securities of an MSCI index.

Investing in foreign securities is subject to certain risks. For example, foreign markets can be extremely volatile. Fluctuations in currency exchange rates also may impact the value of foreign securities denominated in foreign currencies or U.S. dollars, without a change in the intrinsic value of those securities. Additionally, the U.S. dollar value of a foreign security tends to decrease when the value of the U.S. dollar rises against the foreign currency in which the security is denominated and tends to increase when the value of the U.S. dollar falls against such currency. A Fund may attempt to minimize the risk from adverse changes in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies by purchasing and selling forward foreign currency exchange contracts and foreign currency futures contracts and related options. Foreign securities may be less liquid than domestic securities so that a Fund may, at times, be unable to sell foreign securities at desirable prices. Brokerage commissions, custodial fees and other fees also are generally higher for foreign securities. A Fund may have limited legal recourse in the event of default with respect to certain debt securities issued by foreign governments. In addition, foreign governments may impose potentially confiscatory withholding or other taxes, which would reduce a Fund’s return on these securities.

Other risks of investing in foreign securities include: possible delays in the settlement of transactions or in the notification of income; generally less publicly available information about companies; adverse impact of political, social or diplomatic events; possible seizure, expropriation or nationalization of a company or its assets; possible imposition of currency exchange controls; and that foreign companies generally are not subject to accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards comparable to those mandated for domestic companies.

Risks associated with investments in foreign securities are increased with respect to investments in emerging market countries. Political and economic structures in many emerging market countries, especially those in Eastern Europe, the Pacific Basin and the Far East, are undergoing significant evolutionary changes and rapid development, and may lack the social, political and economic stability of more developed countries. Investing in emerging market securities also involves risks beyond the risks applicable to foreign investments. For example, some emerging market countries may have fixed or managed currencies that are not free-floating against the U.S. dollar. Further, certain currencies may not be traded internationally, and some countries with

 

37


Table of Contents

emerging securities markets have sustained long periods of very high inflation or rapid fluctuation in inflation rates which can have negative effects on a country’s economy and securities markets.

Guaranteed Investment Contracts (Funding Agreements)

Guaranteed investment contracts, or funding agreements, are debt instruments issued by insurance companies. Pursuant to such contracts, a Fund may make cash contributions to a deposit fund of the insurance company’s general account. The insurance company then credits to a Fund payments at negotiated, floating or fixed interest rates. A Fund will purchase guaranteed investment contracts only from issuers that, at the time of purchase, meet certain credit and quality standards.

Investing in guaranteed investment contracts is subject to certain risks. In general, guaranteed investment contracts are not assignable or transferable without the permission of the issuing insurance companies, and an active secondary market does not exist for these investments. In addition, the issuer may not be able to pay the principal amount to a Fund on seven days notice or less, at which time the investment may be considered illiquid under applicable SEC regulatory guidance and subject to certain restrictions.

Illiquid Securities

Illiquid securities are defined by a Fund consistent with SEC staff’s current guidance and interpretations which provide that an illiquid security is an asset which may not be sold or disposed of in the ordinary course of business within seven days at approximately the value at which a Fund has valued the investment on its books. Some securities, such as those not registered under U.S. securities laws, cannot be sold in public transactions. Subject to its investment policies, a Fund may invest in illiquid investments and may invest in certain restricted securities that are deemed to be illiquid securities.

Initial Public Offerings

A Fund may invest in initial public offerings (IPOs) of common stock or other primary or secondary syndicated offerings of equity or debt securities issued by a corporate issuer. Fixed income funds frequently invest in these types of offerings of debt securities. A purchase of IPO securities often involves higher transaction costs than those associated with the purchase of securities already traded on exchanges or markets. IPO securities are subject to market risk and liquidity risk. The market value of recently issued IPO securities may fluctuate considerably due to factors such as the absence of a prior public market, unseasoned trading and speculation, a potentially small number of securities available for trading, limited information about the issuer, and other factors. A Fund may hold IPO securities for a period of time, or may sell them soon after the purchase. Investments in IPOs could have a magnified impact – either positive or negative – on a Fund’s performance while the Fund’s assets are relatively small. The impact of an IPO on a Fund’s performance may tend to diminish as the Fund’s assets grow. In circumstances when investments in IPOs make a significant contribution to a Fund’s performance, there can be no assurance that similar contributions from IPOs will continue in the future.

Investments in Other Investment Companies

Investing in other investment companies may be a means by which a Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective. A Fund may invest in securities issued by other investment companies within the limits prescribed by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive orders currently or in the future obtained by a Fund from the SEC.

Except with respect to funds structured as funds-of-funds or so-called master/feeder funds, the 1940 Act generally requires that a fund limit its investments in another investment company or series thereof so that, as determined at the time a securities purchase is made: (i) no more than 5% of the value of its total assets will be invested in the securities of any one investment company; (ii) no more than 10% of the value of its total assets

 

38


Table of Contents

will be invested in the aggregate in securities of other investment companies; and (iii) no more than 3% of the outstanding voting stock of any one investment company or series thereof will be owned by a fund or by companies controlled by a fund. Such other investment companies may include ETFs, which are shares of publicly traded unit investment trusts, open-end funds or depositary receipts that seek to track the performance of specific indexes or companies in related industries.

Investing in other investment companies is subject to certain risks. Although a Fund may derive certain advantages from being able to invest in shares of other investment companies, such as to be fully invested, there may be potential disadvantages. Investing in other investment companies may result in higher fees and expenses for a Fund and its shareholders. A shareholder may be charged fees not only on Fund shares held directly but also on the investment company shares that a Fund purchases.

In addition, investing in ETFs is subject to certain other risks. ETFs generally are subject to the same risks as the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track as well as to the risks of the specific sector or industry to which the ETF relates. ETFs also are subject to the risk that their prices may not totally correlate to the prices of the underlying securities the ETFs are designed to track and the risk of possible trading halts due to market conditions or for other reasons.

Under the 1940 Act and rules and regulations thereunder, a Fund may purchase shares of affiliated funds, subject to certain conditions. Investing in affiliated funds may present certain actual or potential conflicts of interest. For more information about such actual and potential conflicts of interest, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest.

Low and Below Investment Grade Securities

Low and below investment grade securities (below investment grade securities are also known as “junk bonds”) are debt securities with the lowest investment grade rating (e.g., BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by Moody’s), that are below investment grade (e.g., lower than BBB by S&P and Fitch or Baa by Moody’s) or that are unrated but determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality. These types of securities may be issued to fund corporate transactions or restructurings, such as leveraged buyouts, mergers, acquisitions, debt reclassifications or similar events, are more speculative in nature than securities with higher ratings and tend to be more sensitive to credit risk, particularly during a downturn in the economy. These types of securities generally are issued by unseasoned companies without long track records of sales and earnings, or by companies or municipalities that have questionable credit strength. Low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities: (i) likely will have some quality and protective characteristics that, in the judgment of one or more NRSROs, are outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions; (ii) are speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation; and (iii) may have a less liquid secondary market, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities. Low and below investment grade securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities is subject to certain risks. The rates of return on these types of securities generally are higher than the rates of return available on more highly rated securities, but generally involve greater volatility of price and risk of loss of principal and income, including the possibility of default by or insolvency of the issuers of such securities. Accordingly, a Fund may be more dependent on the Adviser’s credit analysis with respect to these types of securities than is the case for more highly rated securities.

 

39


Table of Contents

 

The market values of certain low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities tend to be more sensitive to individual corporate developments and changes in economic conditions than are the market value of more highly rated securities. In addition, issuers of low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities often are highly leveraged and may not have more traditional methods of financing available to them, so that their ability to service their debt obligations during an economic downturn or during sustained periods of rising interest rates may be impaired.

The risk of loss due to default is greater for low and below investment grade and comparable unrated securities than it is for higher rated securities because low and below investment grade securities and comparable unrated securities generally are unsecured and frequently are subordinated to more senior indebtedness. A Fund may incur additional expenses to the extent that it is required to seek recovery upon a default in the payment of principal or interest on its holdings of such securities. The existence of limited markets for lower-rated debt securities may diminish a Fund’s ability to: (i) obtain accurate market quotations for purposes of valuing such securities and calculating portfolio net asset value; and (ii) sell the securities at fair market value either to meet redemption requests or to respond to changes in the economy or in financial markets.

Many lower-rated securities are not registered for offer and sale to the public under the 1933Act. Investments in these restricted securities may be determined to be liquid (able to be sold within seven days at approximately the price at which they are valued by a Fund) pursuant to policies approved by the Fund’s Trustees. Investments in illiquid securities, including restricted securities that have not been determined to be liquid, may not exceed 15% of a Fund’s net assets. A Fund is not otherwise subject to any limitation on its ability to invest in restricted securities. Restricted securities may be less liquid than other lower-rated securities, potentially making it difficult to value or sell such securities.

Money Market Instruments

Money market instruments are high-quality, short-term debt obligations, which include: (i) bank obligations, including certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers’ acceptances; (ii) funding agreements; (iii) repurchase agreements; (iv) obligations of the United States, foreign countries and supranational entities, and each of their subdivisions, agencies and instrumentalities; (v) certain corporate debt securities, such as commercial paper, short-term corporate obligations and extendible commercial notes; (vi) participation interests; and (vii) municipal securities. Money market instruments may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Investing in money market instruments is subject to certain risks. Money market instruments (other than certain U.S. Government obligations) are not backed or insured by the U.S. Government, its agencies or its instrumentalities. Accordingly, only the creditworthiness of an issuer, or guarantees of that issuer, support such instruments.

Mortgage-Backed Securities

Mortgage-backed securities are a type of asset-backed security and represent interests in, or debt instruments backed by, pools of underlying mortgages. In some cases, these underlying mortgages may be insured or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Mortgage-backed securities entitle the security holders to receive distributions that are tied to the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral (less fees paid to the originator, servicer, or other parties, and fees paid for credit enhancement), so that the payments made on the underlying mortgage collateral effectively pass through to such security holders. Mortgage-backed securities are created when mortgage originators (or mortgage loan sellers who have purchased mortgage loans from mortgage loan originators) sell the underlying mortgages to a special purpose entity in a process called a securitization. The special purpose entity issues securities that are backed by the payments on the underlying

 

40


Table of Contents

mortgage loans, and have a minimum denomination and specific term. Mortgage-backed securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Mortgage-backed securities may be issued or guaranteed by GNMA (also known as Ginnie Mae), FNMA (also known as Fannie Mae), or FHLMC (also known as Freddie Mac), but also may be issued or guaranteed by other issuers, including private companies. GNMA is a government-owned corporation that is an agency of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. It guarantees, with the full faith and credit of the United States, full and timely payment of all monthly principal and interest on its mortgage-backed securities. Until recently, FNMA and FHLMC were government-sponsored corporations owned entirely by private stockholders. Both issue mortgage-related securities that contain guarantees as to timely payment of interest and principal but that are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. The value of the companies’ securities fell sharply in 2008 due to concerns that the firms did not have sufficient capital to offset losses. In mid-2008, the U.S. Treasury was authorized to increase the size of home loans that FNMA and FHLMC could purchase in certain residential areas and, until 2009, to lend FNMA and FHLMC emergency funds and to purchase the companies’ stock. In September 2008, the U.S. Treasury announced that FNMA and FHLMC had been placed in conservatorship by the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), a newly created independent regulator. In addition to placing the companies in conservatorship, the U.S. Treasury announced three additional steps that it intended to take with respect to FNMA and FHLMC. First, the U.S. Treasury has entered into “Preferred Stock Purchase Agreements” (PSPAs) under which, if the FHFA determines that FNMA’s or FHLMC’s liabilities have exceeded its assets under generally accepted accounting principles, the U.S. Treasury will contribute cash capital to the company in an amount equal to the difference between liabilities and assets. The PSPAs are designed to provide protection to the senior and subordinated debt and the mortgage-backed securities issued by FNMA and FHLMC. Second, the U.S. Treasury established a new secured lending credit facility that was available to FNMA and FHLMC until December 2009. Third, the U.S. Treasury initiated a temporary program to purchase FNMA and FHLMC mortgage-backed securities that concluded in December 2009. Although the U.S. Government has provided support to FNMA and FHLMC, there can be no assurances that it will support these and other government sponsored enterprises in the future.

CMOs are debt obligations issued by special-purpose trusts, collateralized by underlying mortgage assets. Principal prepayments on underlying mortgage assets may cause the CMOs to be retired substantially earlier than their stated maturities or final distribution dates, resulting in a loss of all or part of the premium if any has been paid. Interest is paid or accrues on all classes of the CMOs on a periodic basis. The principal and interest payments on the underlying mortgage assets may be allocated among the various classes of CMOs in several ways. Typically, payments of principal, including any prepayments, on the underlying mortgage assets are applied to the classes in the order of their respective stated maturities or final distribution dates, so that no payment of principal is made on CMOs of a class until all CMOs of other classes having earlier stated maturities or final distribution dates have been paid in full.

REMICs are entities that own mortgages and elect REMIC status under the Code and, like CMOs, issue debt obligations collateralized by underlying mortgage assets that have characteristics similar to those issued by CMOs.

Investing in mortgage-backed securities is subject to certain risks, including, among others, prepayment, market and credit risks. Prepayment risk reflects the risk that borrowers may prepay their mortgages more quickly than expected, which may affect the security’s average maturity and rate of return. Whether or not a mortgage loan is prepaid is almost entirely controlled by the borrower. Borrowers are most likely to exercise prepayment options at the time when it is least advantageous to investors, generally prepaying mortgages as interest rates fall, and slowing payments as interest rates rise. Besides the effect of prevailing interest rates, the

 

41


Table of Contents

rate of prepayment and refinancing of mortgages also may be affected by home value appreciation, ease of the refinancing process and local economic conditions, among other factors. Market risk reflects the risk that the price of a security may fluctuate over time. The price of mortgage-backed securities can be particularly sensitive to prevailing interest rates, the length of time the security is expected to be outstanding and the liquidity of the issue. In a period of unstable interest rates, there may be decreased demand for certain types of mortgage-backed securities, which in turn may decrease their value. Credit risk reflects the risk that a holder of mortgage-backed securities may not receive all or part of its principal because the issuer, any credit enhancer and/or the underlying mortgage borrower has defaulted on its obligations. Credit risk is increased for mortgage-backed securities that are backed by mortgages to so-called subprime borrowers (who may pose a greater risk of defaulting on their loans) or that are subordinated to another security (i.e., if the holder of a mortgage-backed security is entitled to receive payments only after payment obligations to holders of the other security are satisfied). The more deeply subordinated the security, the greater the credit risk associated with the security will be. Mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers, whether or not such obligations are subject to guarantees by the private issuer, may entail greater risk than mortgage-backed securities guaranteed by the U.S. Government. The performance of mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers generally depends on the financial health of those institutions.

Municipal Securities

Municipal securities include debt obligations issued by governmental entities to obtain funds for various public purposes, including the construction of a wide range of public facilities, the refunding of outstanding obligations, the payment of general operating expenses, and the extension of loans to public institutions and facilities. Municipal securities can be classified into two principal categories, including “general obligation” bonds and other securities and “revenue” bonds and other securities. General obligation bonds are secured by the issuer’s full faith, credit and taxing power for the payment of principal and interest. Revenue securities are payable only from the revenues derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue source, such as the user of the facility being financed. Municipal securities also may include “moral obligation” securities, which normally are issued by special purpose public authorities. If the issuer of moral obligation securities is unable to meet its debt service obligations from current revenues, it may draw on a reserve fund, the restoration of which is a moral commitment but not a legal obligation of the governmental entity that created the special purpose public authority. Municipal securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Municipal securities may include municipal bonds, municipal notes and municipal leases. Municipal bonds are debt obligations of a governmental entity that obligate the municipality to pay the holder a specified sum of money at specified intervals and to repay the principal amount of the loan at maturity.

Municipal notes may be issued by governmental entities and other tax-exempt issuers in order to finance short-term cash needs or, occasionally, to finance construction. Most municipal notes are general obligations of the issuing entity payable from taxes or designated revenues expected to be received within the relevant fiscal period. Municipal notes generally have maturities of one year or less. Municipal notes can be subdivided into two sub-categories: (i) municipal commercial paper and (ii) municipal demand obligations.

Municipal commercial paper typically consists of very short-term unsecured negotiable promissory notes that are sold, for example, to meet seasonal working capital or interim construction financing needs of a governmental entity or agency. While these obligations are intended to be paid from general revenues or refinanced with long-term debt, they frequently are backed by letters of credit, lending agreements, note repurchase agreements or other credit facility agreements offered by banks or institutions.

 

42


Table of Contents

 

Municipal demand obligations can be subdivided into two general types: variable rate demand notes and master demand obligations. Variable rate demand notes are tax-exempt municipal obligations or participation interests that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid on the notes. They permit the holder to demand payment of the notes, or to demand purchase of the notes at a purchase price equal to the unpaid principal balance, plus accrued interest either directly by the issuer or by drawing on a bank letter of credit or guaranty issued with respect to such note. The issuer of the municipal obligation may have a corresponding right to prepay at its discretion the outstanding principal of the note plus accrued interest upon notice comparable to that required for the holder to demand payment. The variable rate demand notes in which a Fund may invest are payable, or are subject to purchase, on demand usually on notice of seven calendar days or less. The terms of the notes generally provide that interest rates are adjustable at intervals ranging from daily to six months.

Master demand obligations are tax-exempt municipal obligations that provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid and permit daily changes in the amount borrowed. The interest on such obligations is, in the opinion of counsel for the borrower, excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes (but not necessarily for alternative minimum tax purposes). Although there is no secondary market for master demand obligations, such obligations are considered by a Fund to be liquid because they are payable upon demand.

Municipal lease obligations are participations in privately arranged loans to state or local government borrowers. In general, such loans are unrated, in which case they will be determined by the Adviser to be of comparable quality at the time of purchase to rated instruments that may be acquired by a Fund. Frequently, privately arranged loans have variable interest rates and may be backed by a bank letter of credit. In other cases, they may be unsecured or may be secured by assets not easily liquidated. Moreover, such loans in most cases are not backed by the taxing authority of the issuers and may have limited marketability or may be marketable only by virtue of a provision requiring repayment following demand by the lender.

Although lease obligations do not constitute general obligations of the municipal issuer to which the government’s taxing power is pledged, a lease obligation ordinarily is backed by the government’s covenant to budget for, appropriate, and make the payments due under the lease obligation. However, certain lease obligations contain “non-appropriation” clauses that provide that the government has no obligation to make lease or installment purchase payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a periodic basis. In the case of a “non-appropriation” lease, a Fund’s ability to recover under the lease in the event of non-appropriation or default likely will be limited to the repossession of the leased property in the event that foreclosure proves difficult.

Tender option bonds are municipal securities having relatively long maturities and bearing interest at a fixed interest rate substantially higher than prevailing short-term tax-exempt rates that is coupled with the agreement of a third party, such as a bank, broker/dealer or other financial institution, to grant the security holders the option, at periodic intervals, to tender their securities to the institution and receive the face value thereof. The financial institution receives periodic fees equal to the difference between the municipal security’s coupon rate and the rate that would cause the security to trade at face value on the date of determination.

Investing in municipal securities is subject to certain risks. There are variations in the quality of municipal securities, both within a particular classification and between classifications, and the rates of return on municipal securities can depend on a variety of factors, including general money market conditions, the financial condition of the issuer, general conditions of the municipal bond market, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. The ratings of NRSROs represent their opinions as to the quality of municipal securities. It should be emphasized, however, that these ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality, and municipal securities with the same maturity, interest rate, and rating may have different rates of return while municipal securities of the same maturity and interest rate with different ratings may have the same rate of return.

 

43


Table of Contents

 

The payment of principal and interest on most municipal securities purchased by a Fund will depend upon the ability of the issuers to meet their obligations. An issuer’s obligations under its municipal securities are subject to the provisions of bankruptcy, insolvency, and other laws affecting the rights and remedies of creditors, such as the United States Bankruptcy Code. The power or ability of an issuer to meet its obligations for the payment of interest on and principal of its municipal securities may be materially adversely affected by litigation or other conditions.

There are particular considerations and risks relevant to investing in a portfolio of a single state’s municipal securities, such as the greater risk of the concentration of portfolio holdings.

The Funds ordinarily purchase municipal securities whose interest, in the opinion of bond counsel, is excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes. The opinion of bond counsel may assert that such interest is not an item of tax preference for the purposes of the alternative minimum tax or is exempt from certain state or local taxes. There is no assurance that the applicable taxing authority will agree with this opinion. In the event, for example, the IRS determines that an issuer does not comply with relevant tax requirements, interest payments from a security could become federally taxable, possibly retroactively to the date the security was issued. As a shareholder of the Fund, you may be required to file an amended tax return as a result, reporting such income as taxable.

For more information about the key risks associated with investments in states, see Appendix D.

Participation Interests

Participation interests (also called pass-through certificates or securities) represent an interest in a pool of debt obligations, such as municipal bonds or notes, that have been “packaged” by an intermediary, such as a bank or broker/dealer. Participation interests typically are issued by partnerships or trusts through which a Fund receives principal and interest payments that are passed through to the holder of the participation interest from the payments made on the underlying debt obligations. The purchaser of a participation interest receives an undivided interest in the underlying debt obligations. The issuers of the underlying debt obligations make interest and principal payments to the intermediary, as an initial purchaser, which are passed through to purchasers in the secondary market, such as a Fund. Mortgage-backed securities are a common type of participation interest. Participation interests may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations or as zero-coupon, pay-in- kind and step-coupon securities and may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations, Permissible Fund Investments – Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities and Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Loan participations also are a type of participation interest. Loan participations are interests in loans that are administered by a lending bank or agent for a syndicate of lending banks and sold by the bank or syndicate members.

Investing in participation interests is subject to certain risks. Participation interests generally are subject to the credit risk associated with the underlying borrowers. If the underlying borrower defaults, a Fund may be subject to delays, expenses and risks that are greater than those that would have been involved if a Fund had purchased a direct obligation of the borrower. A Fund also may be deemed a creditor of the lending bank or syndicate members and be subject to the risk that the lending bank or syndicate members may become insolvent.

Preferred Stock

Preferred stock represents units of ownership of a corporation that frequently have dividends that are set at a specified rate. Preferred stock has preference over common stock in the payment of dividends and the liquidation of assets. Preferred stock shares some of the characteristics of both debt and equity. Preferred stock ordinarily

 

44


Table of Contents

does not carry voting rights. Most preferred stock is cumulative; if dividends are passed (i.e., not paid for any reason), they accumulate and must be paid before common stock dividends. Participating preferred stock entitles its holders to share in profits above and beyond the declared dividend, along with common shareholders, as distinguished from nonparticipating preferred stock, which is limited to the stipulated dividend. Convertible preferred stock is exchangeable for a given number of shares of common stock and thus tends to be more volatile than nonconvertible preferred stock, which generally behaves more like a fixed income bond. Preferred stock may be privately placed or publicly offered. See Permissible Fund Investments – Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities for more information.

Auction preferred stock (APS) is a type of adjustable-rate preferred stock with a dividend determined periodically in a Dutch auction process by corporate bidders. Shares typically are bought and sold at face values generally ranging from $100,000 to $500,000 per share.

In addition to reinvestment risk if interest rates fall, some specific risks with regard to APS include:

 

   

Failed auction: A breakdown of the auction process can occur. In the event that the process fails, the rate is reset at the maximum applicable rate, which is usually described in the prospectuses and typically is influenced by the issuer’s credit rating. In a failed auction, current shareholders generally are unable to sell some, or all, of the shares when the auction is completed. Typically, the liquidity for APS that have experienced a failed auction becomes very limited. If a failed auction were to occur, the shareholder generally would hold his or her shares until the next auction. Should there not be subsequent auctions that “cure” the failed process, the shareholder may: (1) hold the APS in anticipation of a refinancing by the issuer that would cause the APS to be called, or (2) hold securities either indefinitely or in anticipation of the development of a secondary market.

 

   

Early call risk: APS generally is redeemable at any time, usually upon notice, at the issuer’s option, at par plus accrued dividends.

Investing in preferred stock is subject to certain risks. For example, stock market risk is the risk that the value of such stocks, like the broader stock markets, may decline over short or even extended periods. Domestic and foreign stock markets tend to be cyclical, with periods when prices generally rise and periods when prices generally decline. The value of individual stocks will rise and decline based on factors specific to each corporation, such as changes in earnings or management.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular company. For example, stocks of smaller companies tend to have greater price fluctuations than stocks of larger companies because, among other things, they trade less frequently and in lower volumes, are more susceptible to changes in economic conditions, are more reliant on singular products or services and are more vulnerable to larger competitors. Stocks of these companies may have a higher potential for gains but also are subject to greater risk of loss.

Investing in preferred stock also may involve the risks applicable to investing in a particular industry, such as technology, financial services, consumer goods or natural resources (e.g., oil and gas). To some extent, the prices of stocks tend to move by industry sector. When market conditions favorably affect, or are expected to favorably affect, an industry, the prices of the stocks of companies in that industry tend to rise. Conversely, negative news or a poor outlook for a particular industry can cause the value of those companies’ stock to decline.

Private Placement and Other Restricted Securities

Private placement securities are securities that have been privately placed and are not registered under the 1933 Act. They are eligible for sale only to certain eligible investors. Private placements often may offer attractive opportunities for investment not otherwise available on the open market. Private placement and other

 

45


Table of Contents

“restricted” securities often cannot be sold to the public without registration under the 1933 Act or the availability of an exemption from registration (such as Rules 144 or 144A), or they are “not readily marketable” because they are subject to other legal or contractual delays in or restrictions on resale. Asset-backed securities, common stock, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, preferred stock and other types of equity and debt instruments may be privately placed or restricted securities.

Private placements typically may be sold only to qualified institutional buyers (or, in the case of the initial sale of certain securities, such as those issued in collateralized debt obligations or collateralized loan obligations, to accredited investors (as defined in Rule 501(a) under the 1933 Act), or in a privately negotiated transaction or to a limited number of purchasers, or in limited quantities after they have been held for a specified period of time and other conditions are met pursuant to an exemption from registration.

Investing in private placement and other restricted securities is subject to certain risks. Private placements may be considered illiquid securities. Private placements typically are subject to restrictions on resale as a matter of contract or under federal securities laws. Because there may be relatively few potential purchasers for such securities, especially under adverse market or economic conditions or in the event of adverse changes in the financial condition of the issuer, a Fund could find it more difficult to sell such securities when it may be advisable to do so or it may be able to sell such securities only at prices lower than if such securities were more widely held. At times, it also may be more difficult to determine the fair value of such securities for purposes of computing a Fund’s net asset value due to the absence of a trading market.

Real Estate Investment Trusts and Master Limited Partnerships

REITs are entities that either own properties or make construction or mortgage loans and also may include operating or finance companies. An equity REIT generally holds equity positions in real estate and seeks to provide its shareholders with income from the leasing of its properties and with capital gains from any sales of properties. A mortgage REIT generally specializes in lending money to owners of properties and passes through any interest income it may earn to its shareholders.

Partnership units of real estate and other types of companies sometimes are organized as master limited partnerships in which ownership interests are publicly traded. Master limited partnerships often own several properties or businesses (or directly own interests) that are related to real estate development and the oil and gas industries, but they also may finance motion pictures, research and development and other projects.

REITs are subject to certain risks associated with direct ownership of real estate, including, for example, declines in the value of real estate, risks related to general and local economic conditions, overbuilding and increased competition, increases in property taxes and operating expenses, and variations in rental income. REITs also may be subject to interest rate risk. In general, increases in interest rates will decrease the value of high-yield securities and increase the costs of obtaining financing, which could decrease the value of a REIT’s investments. In addition, equity REITs may be affected by changes in the value of the underlying property owned by the REITs, while mortgage REITs may be affected by the quality of credit extended. Both equity and mortgage REITs are dependent upon management skills. REITs also may be subject to heavy cash flow dependency, defaults by borrowers, and the possibility of failing to qualify for preferential tax treatment under the Code, which could adversely affect dividend payments. REITs also may not be diversified.

Investing in master limited partnerships generally is subject to the risks applicable to investing in a partnership as opposed to a corporation, which may include fewer protections afforded to investors. Additional risks include those associated with the specific industries in which a master limited partnership invests, such as the risks associated with investing in the real estate or oil and gas industries.

 

46


Table of Contents

 

Repurchase Agreements

Repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund acquires a security for a relatively short period of time subject to the obligation of a seller to repurchase and a Fund to resell such security at a fixed time and price (representing a Fund’s cost plus interest). Repurchase agreements also may be viewed as loans made by a Fund that are collateralized by the securities subject to repurchase. A Fund typically will enter into repurchase agreements only with commercial banks, registered broker/dealers and the Fixed Income Clearing Corporation. Such transactions are monitored to ensure that the value of the underlying securities will be at least equal at all times to the total amount of the repurchase obligation, including any accrued interest. Repurchase agreements generally are subject to counterparty risk.

If a counterparty defaults, a Fund could realize a loss on the sale of the underlying security to the extent that the proceeds of the sale are less than the resale price provided in the repurchase agreement including interest. In the event that a counterparty fails to perform because it is insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund’s right to take possession of the underlying securities would be subject to applicable insolvency law and procedure, including an automatic stay (which would preclude immediate enforcement of a Fund’s rights) and exemptions thereto (which would permit a Fund to take possession of the underlying securities or to void a repurchase agreement altogether). Since it is possible that an exemption from the automatic stay would not be available, a Fund might be prevented from immediately enforcing its rights against the counterparty. Accordingly, if a counterparty becomes insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency proceedings against it, a Fund may incur delays in or be prevented from liquidating the underlying securities and could experience losses, including the possible decline in value of the underlying securities during the period in which a Fund seeks to enforce its rights thereto, possible subnormal levels of income or lack of access to income during such time, as well as the costs incurred in enforcing a Fund’s rights. For example, if a Fund enters into a repurchase agreement with a broker that becomes insolvent, it is possible for the Securities Investor Protection Corporation (SIPC) to institute a liquidation proceeding in federal court against the broker counterparty which could lead to a foreclosure by SIPC of the underlying securities or SIPC may stay, or preclude, a Fund’s ability under contract to terminate the repurchase agreement.

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

Reverse repurchase agreements are agreements under which a Fund sells a security subject to the obligation of a buyer to resell and a Fund to repurchase such security at a fixed time and price. Reverse repurchase agreements also may be viewed as borrowings made by a Fund.

Reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities a Fund is obligated to repurchase under the agreement may decline below the repurchase price. In the event the buyer of securities under a reverse repurchase agreement files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, a Fund’s use of proceeds of the agreement may be restricted pending a determination by the other party, or its trustee or receiver, whether to enforce a Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities. In addition, reverse repurchase agreements are techniques involving leverage, and are subject to asset coverage requirements. Under the requirements of the 1940 Act, a Fund is required to maintain an asset coverage (including the proceeds of the borrowings) of at least 300% of all borrowings.

Standby Commitments

Standby commitments are securities under which a purchaser, usually a bank or broker/dealer, agrees to purchase, for a fee, an amount of a Fund’s municipal obligations. The amount payable by a bank or broker/dealer to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment typically will be substantially the same as the value of the underlying municipal securities. A Fund may pay for standby commitments either separately in cash or by paying a higher price for portfolio securities that are acquired subject to such a commitment.

Using standby commitments is subject to certain risks. Standby commitments are subject to the risk that a counterparty will not fulfill its obligation to purchase securities subject to a standby commitment.

 

47


Table of Contents

 

Stripped Securities

Stripped securities are securities that evidence ownership in either the future interest or principal payments on an instrument. There are many different types and variations of stripped securities. For example, Separate Trading of Registered Interest and Principal Securities (STRIPS), can be component parts of a U.S. Treasury security where the principal and interest components are traded independently through DTC, a clearing agency registered pursuant to Section 17A of the 1934 Act and created to hold securities for its participants, and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between participants through electronic computerized book-entries, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of certificates. Treasury Investor Growth Receipts (TIGERs) are U.S. Treasury securities stripped by brokers. Stripped mortgage-backed securities, or SMBS, also can be issued by the U.S. Government or its agencies. Stripped securities may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

SMBS usually are structured with two or more classes that receive different proportions of the interest and principal distributions from a pool of mortgage-backed assets. Common types of SMBS will be structured so that one class receives some of the interest and most of the principal from the mortgage-backed assets, while another class receives most of the interest and the remainder of the principal.

Investing in stripped securities is subject to certain risks. If the underlying obligations experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, a Fund may fail fully to recoup its initial investment in such securities. The market value of the class consisting primarily or entirely of principal payments can be especially volatile in response to changes in interest rates. The rates of return on a class of SMBS that receives all or most of the interest are generally higher than prevailing market rates of return on other mortgage-backed obligations because their cash flow patterns also are volatile and there is a greater risk that the initial investment will not be recouped fully.

U.S. Government and Related Obligations

U.S. Government obligations include U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government or by various instrumentalities which have been established or sponsored by the U.S. Government. U.S. Treasury obligations and securities issued or guaranteed by various agencies of the U.S. Government differ in their interest rates, maturities and time of issuance, as well as with respect to whether they are guaranteed by the U.S. Government. U.S. Government and related obligations may be structured as fixed-, variable- or floating-rate obligations. See Permissible Fund Investments – Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations for more information.

U.S. Government obligations also include senior unsecured debt securities issued between October 14, 2008 and June 30, 2009 by eligible issuers (including U.S. depository institutions insured by the FDIC (and certain affiliates), U.S. bank holding companies and certain U.S. savings and loan holding companies) that are guaranteed by the FDIC under its Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (the “TLGP”). The FDIC’s guarantee under the TLGP will expire upon the earlier of (i) maturity of such security or (ii) June 30, 2012. It is the view of the FDIC and the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission that any debt security that is guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP and that has a maturity that ends on or before June 30, 2012 would be a security exempt from registration under Section 3(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933 because such security would be fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the FDIC.

Investing in securities guaranteed under the TLGP is subject to certain risks. Given that there is a limited track record for securities guaranteed under the TLGP, it is uncertain whether such securities will continue to trade in line with recent experience in relation to treasury and government agency securities in terms of yield spread and the volatility of such spread and it is uncertain how such securities will trade in the secondary market and whether that market will be liquid or illiquid. The TLGP is a new program that is subject to change. In order

 

48


Table of Contents

to collect from the FDIC under the TLGP, a claims process must be followed. Failure to follow the claims process could result in a loss to the right to payment under the guarantee. In addition, guarantee payments by the FDIC under the TLGP may be delayed.

Investing in U.S. Government and related obligations is subject to certain risks. While U.S. Treasury obligations are backed by the “full faith and credit” of the U.S. Government, securities issued or guaranteed by federal agencies and U.S. Government-sponsored instrumentalities may or may not be backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. These securities may be supported by the ability to borrow from the U.S. Treasury or only by the credit of the issuing agency or instrumentality and, as a result, may be subject to greater credit risk than securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Treasury. Obligations of U.S. Government agencies, authorities, instrumentalities and sponsored enterprises historically have involved limited risk of loss of principal if held to maturity. However, no assurance can be given that the U.S. Government would provide financial support to any of these entities if it is not obligated to do so by law.

Variable- and Floating-Rate Obligations

Variable- and floating-rate obligations provide for periodic adjustments in the interest rate and, under certain circumstances, varying principal amounts. Unlike a fixed interest rate, a variable, or floating, rate is one that rises and declines based on the movement of an underlying index of interest rates and may pay interest at rates that are adjusted periodically according to a specified formula. Asset-backed securities, bank obligations, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, money market instruments, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as variable- and floating-rate obligations.

Investing in variable- and floating-rate obligations is subject to certain risks. Variable- and floating-rate obligations may involve direct lending arrangements between the purchaser and the issuer and there may be no active secondary market, making it difficult to resell such obligations to a third party. Variable- and floating-rate obligations also may be subject to interest rate and credit risks. Changes in interest rates can affect the rate of return on such obligations. If an issuer of a variable- or floating-rate obligation defaults, a Fund could sustain a loss to the extent of such default.

Warrants and Rights

Warrants and rights are types of securities that give a holder a right to purchase shares of common stock. Warrants usually are issued together with a bond or preferred stock and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock at a specified price typically for a period of years. Rights usually have a specified purchase price that is lower than the current market price and entitle a holder to purchase a specified amount of common stock typically for a period of only weeks. Warrants may be used to enhance the marketability of a bond or preferred stock.

Warrants and rights may be subject to the risk that the securities could lose value. There also is the risk that the potential exercise price may exceed the market price of the warrants or rights, such as when there is no movement in the market price or the market price of such securities declines.

When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Transactions

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the purchase or sale of securities by a Fund, with payment and delivery taking place in the future. When engaging in when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions, a Fund typically will hold cash or liquid securities in a segregated account in an amount equal to or greater than the purchase price. The payment obligation and, if applicable, the interest rate that will be received on the securities, are fixed at the time that a Fund agrees to purchase the securities. A Fund generally will enter into when-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment

 

49


Table of Contents

transactions only with the intention of completing such transactions. However, the Adviser may determine not to complete a transaction if it deems it appropriate. In such cases, a Fund may realize short-term gains or losses.

When-issued, delayed delivery and forward commitment transactions involve the risks that the securities purchased may fall in value by the time they actually are issued or that the other party may fail to honor the contract terms. A Fund that invests in delayed delivery securities may rely on a third party to complete the transaction. Failure by a third party to deliver a security purchased on a delayed delivery basis may result in a financial loss to a Fund or the loss of an opportunity to make an alternative investment.

Zero-Coupon, Pay-in-Kind and Step-Coupon Securities

Zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities are types of debt instruments that do not necessarily make payments of interest in fixed amounts or at fixed intervals. Asset-backed securities, convertible securities, corporate debt securities, foreign securities, low and below investment grade securities, mortgage-backed securities, municipal securities, participation interests, stripped securities, U.S. Government and related obligations and other types of debt instruments may be structured as zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities.

Zero-coupon securities do not pay interest on a current basis but instead accrue interest over the life of the security. These securities include, among others, zero-coupon bonds, which either may be issued at a discount by a corporation or government entity or may be created by a brokerage firm when it strips the coupons from a bond or note and then sells the bond or note and the coupon separately. This technique is used frequently with U.S. Treasury bonds, and zero-coupon securities are marketed under such names as CATS (Certificate of Accrual on Treasury Securities), TIGERs or STRIPS. Zero-coupon bonds also are issued by municipalities. Buying a municipal zero-coupon bond frees its purchaser of the obligation to pay regular federal income tax on imputed interest, since the interest is exempt for regular federal income tax purposes. Zero-coupon certificates of deposit and zero-coupon mortgages are generally structured in the same fashion as zero-coupon bonds; the certificate of deposit holder or mortgage holder receives face value at maturity and no payments until then.

Pay-in-kind securities normally give the issuer an option to pay cash at a coupon payment date or to give the holder of the security a similar security with the same coupon rate and a face value equal to the amount of the coupon payment that would have been made.

Step-coupon securities trade at a discount from their face value and pay coupon interest. The coupon rate is paid according to a schedule for a series of periods, typically lower for an initial period and then increasing to a higher coupon rate thereafter. The discount from the face amount or par value depends on the time remaining until cash payments begin, prevailing interest rates, liquidity of the security and the perceived credit quality of the issue.

Zero-coupon, step-coupon and pay-in-kind securities holders generally have substantially all the rights and privileges of holders of the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations. Holders of these securities have the right upon default on the underlying coupon obligations or principal obligations to proceed directly and individually against the issuer and are not required to act in concert with other holders of such securities.

Investing in zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities is subject to certain risks, including that market prices of zero-coupon, pay-in-kind and step-coupon securities generally are more volatile than the prices of securities that pay interest periodically and in cash, and are likely to respond to changes in interest rates to a greater degree than other types of debt securities.

Because zero-coupon securities bear no interest, they are volatile. Since zero-coupon bondholders do not receive interest payments, zero-coupon securities fall more dramatically than bonds paying interest on a current basis when interest rates rise. However, when interest rates fall, zero-coupon securities rise more rapidly in value than interest paying bonds.

 

50


Table of Contents

 

Borrowings

Each Fund has a fundamental policy with respect to borrowing that can be found under the heading About the Funds’ Investments – Fundamental and Non-Fundamental Investment Policies. Specifically, each Fund may not borrow money or issue senior securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any exemptive relief obtained by the Funds. In general, pursuant to the 1940 Act, a Fund may borrow money only from banks in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings). Any borrowings that come to exceed this amount must be reduced within three days (not including Sundays and holidays) to the extent necessary to comply with the 33 1/3% limitation.

The Funds participate in a committed line of credit (Line of Credit). Any advance under the Line of Credit is contemplated primarily for temporary or emergency purposes, including the meeting of redemption requests that otherwise might require the untimely sale of portfolio securities.

Pursuant to an exemptive order from the SEC, a Fund may, subject to certain conditions, borrow money from or lend money to other funds in the Columbia Funds Family or any other registered investment company advised by the Adviser or its affiliates for temporary emergency purposes in order to facilitate redemption requests, or for other purposes consistent with Fund investment policies and restrictions. All loans are set at an interest rate between the rates charged on overnight repurchase agreements and short-term bank loans.

Short Sales

A Fund may sometimes sell securities short when it owns an equal amount of such securities as those securities sold short. This is a technique known as selling short “against the box.” If a Fund makes a short sale “against the box,” it would not immediately deliver the securities sold and would not receive the proceeds from the sale. The seller is said to have a short position in the securities sold until it delivers the securities sold, at which time it receives the proceeds of the sale. To secure its obligation to deliver securities sold short, a Fund will deposit in escrow in a separate account with the custodian an equal amount of the securities sold short or securities convertible into or exchangeable for such securities. A Fund can close out its short position by purchasing and delivering an equal amount of the securities sold short, rather than by delivering securities already held by a Fund, because a Fund might want to continue to receive interest and dividend payments on securities in its portfolio that are convertible into the securities sold short.

Short sales “against the box” entail many of the same risks and considerations described above regarding short sales not “against the box.” However, when a Fund sells short “against the box” it typically limits the amount of securities that it has leveraged. A Fund’s decision to make a short sale “against the box” may be a technique to hedge against market risks when the Adviser believes that the price of a security may decline, causing a decline in the value of a security owned by a Fund or a security convertible into or exchangeable for such security. In such case, any future losses in a Fund’s long position would be reduced by a gain in the short position. The extent to which such gains or losses in the long position are reduced will depend upon the amount of securities sold short relative to the amount of the securities a Fund owns, either directly or indirectly, and, in the case where a Fund owns convertible securities, changes in the investment values or conversion premiums of such securities. Short sales may have adverse tax consequences to a Fund and its shareholders.

Subject to its fundamental and non-fundamental investment policies, a Fund may engage in short sales that are not “against the box,” which are sales by a Fund of securities or commodity futures contracts that it does not own in hopes of purchasing the same security at a later date at a lower price. The technique is also used to protect a profit in a long-term position in a security or commodity futures contract. To make delivery to the buyer, a Fund must borrow or purchase the security. If borrowed, a Fund is then obligated to replace the security borrowed from the third party, so a Fund must purchase the security at the market price at a later time. If the price of the security has increased during this time, then a Fund will incur a loss equal to the increase in price of

 

51


Table of Contents

the security from the time of the short sale plus any premiums and interest paid to the third party. (Until the security is replaced, a Fund is required to pay to the lender amounts equal to any dividends or interest which accrue during the period of the loan. To borrow the security, a Fund also may be required to pay a premium, which would increase the cost of the security sold. The proceeds of the short sale will be retained by the broker, to the extent necessary to meet the margin requirements, until the short position is closed out.)

Short sales by a Fund that are not made “against the box” create opportunities to increase a Fund’s return but, at the same time, involve specific risk considerations and may be considered a speculative technique. Because a Fund in effect profits from a decline in the price of the securities sold short without the need to invest the full purchase price of the securities on the date of the short sale, a Fund’s NAV per share tends to increase more when the securities it has sold short decrease in value, and to decrease more when the securities it has sold short increase in value, than if it had not engaged in such short sales. The amount of any gain will be decreased, and the amount of any loss increased, by the amount of any premium, dividends or interest a Fund may be required to pay in connection with the short sale. Short sales could potentially involve unlimited loss, as the market price of securities sold short may continually increase, although a Fund can mitigate any such losses by replacing the securities sold short. Under adverse market conditions, a Fund might have difficulty purchasing securities to meet its short sale delivery obligations, and might have to sell portfolio securities to raise the capital necessary to meet its short sale obligations at a time when fundamental investment considerations would not favor such sales. There is also the risk that the third party to the short sale may fail to honor its contract terms, causing a loss to a Fund.

A Fund’s successful use of short sales also will be subject to the ability of the Adviser to predict movements in the directions of the relevant market. A Fund therefore bears the risk that the Adviser will incorrectly predict future price directions. In addition, if a Fund sells a security short, and that security’s price goes up, a Fund will have to make up the margin on its open position (i.e., purchase more securities on the market to cover the position). It may be unable to do so and thus its position may not be closed out. There can be no assurance that a Fund will not incur significant losses in such a case.

In the view of the SEC, a short sale involves the creation of a “senior security” as such term is defined in the 1940 Act, unless the sale is “against the box” and the securities sold short are placed in a segregated account (not with the broker), or unless a Fund’s obligation to deliver the securities sold short is “covered” by placing in a segregated account (not with the broker) cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities in an amount equal to the difference between the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale and any such collateral required to be deposited with a broker in connection with the sale (not including the proceeds from the short sale), which difference is adjusted daily for changes in the value of the securities sold short. The total value of the cash, U.S. Government securities or other liquid debt or equity securities deposited with the broker and otherwise segregated may not at any time be less than the market value of the securities sold short at the time of the short sale.

Lending Securities

Securities lending refers to the lending of the Fund’s portfolio securities. Subject to its investment policies described above and in the prospectuses, the Fund may make secured loans of its portfolio securities to broker/dealers and other institutional investors. Securities loans by the Fund are made pursuant to agreements that require that loans be secured continuously by collateral in cash. The Fund retains all or a portion of the income received on investment of cash collateral. A borrower will pay to the Fund an amount equal to any dividends or interest received on securities loaned, but the borrower typically will receive a portion of the income earned on investments of cash collateral. Although voting rights, or rights to consent, with respect to loaned securities pass to a borrower, the Fund retains the right to call the loans at any time on reasonable notice, and may do so in order to vote upon matters affecting, or to sell, the loaned securities.

The Fund typically invests the cash collateral it receives in connection with its securities lending program directly or indirectly in high quality, short-term investments. The Fund may invest some or all of such cash

 

52


Table of Contents

collateral in one or more pooled investment vehicles, including, among other vehicles, money market funds managed by the Fund’s securities lending agent or its affiliates. The securities lending agent shares in any income resulting from the investment of such cash collateral, and an affiliate of the securities lending agent receives asset-based fees for the management of such pooled investment vehicles, which may create a conflict of interest between the securities lending agent (or its affiliate) and the Fund with respect to the management of such cash collateral.

Engaging in securities lending is subject to certain risks, including counterparty risk, which is the risk that the counterparty to a transaction could default. There also is a risk of possible delay in the recovery of loaned securities or possible loss of rights in the collateral if a borrower fails financially.

Portfolio Turnover

A change in the securities held by a Fund is known as “portfolio turnover.” High portfolio turnover (e.g., over 100%) involves correspondingly greater expenses to the Fund, including brokerage commissions or dealer mark-ups and other transaction costs on the sale of securities and reinvestments in other securities. Such sales may also result in adverse tax consequences to a Fund’s shareholders. The trading costs and tax effects associated with portfolio turnover may adversely affect a Fund’s performance.

For each Fund’s portfolio turnover rate, see the Fees and Expenses of the Fund — Portfolio Turnover section in the prospectuses for that Fund.

In any particular year, market conditions may result in greater rates than are presently anticipated. The rate of a Fund’s turnover may vary significantly from time to time depending on the volatility of economic and market conditions.

Disclosure of Portfolio Information

The Board has adopted policies and procedures with respect to the disclosure of each Fund’s portfolio holdings. These policies and procedures are designed to ensure that disclosure of information regarding a Fund’s portfolio securities is in the best interests of Fund shareholders and to address conflicts between the interests of Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Fund, on the other. These policies and procedures provide that a Fund’s portfolio holdings information generally may not be disclosed to any party prior to the earlier of: (i) the business day next following the posting of such information on the Columbia Funds’ website, if applicable, or (ii) the time a Fund discloses the information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information. Certain limited exceptions that have been approved consistent with the policies and procedures are described below. The Board is updated as needed regarding compliance with these policies and procedures. The policies and procedures prohibit the Adviser and a Fund’s other service providers from entering into any agreement to disclose Fund portfolio holdings information in exchange for any form of consideration. The same policies and procedures apply to all categories of Columbia Funds and include some variations tailored to the different categories of Columbia Funds. Accordingly, some of the provisions described below do not apply to the Columbia Funds covered by this SAI. The Adviser also has adopted policies and procedures to monitor for compliance with these portfolio holdings disclosure policies and procedures.

Public Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings are currently disclosed to the public through required filings with the SEC and on the Columbia Funds’ website. This information is available on the Columbia Funds’ website as described below.

 

   

For equity, convertible, balanced and asset allocation Columbia Funds, other than small cap and specialty Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 15 calendar days after such month-end.

 

53


Table of Contents

 

   

For small cap and specialty Columbia Funds and those Columbia Funds that are sub-advised by Marsico and Brandes, subadvisers for certain Columbia Funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a month end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such month-end.

 

   

For fixed-income funds, a complete list of portfolio holdings as of a calendar quarter-end is posted approximately but no earlier than 30 calendar days after such quarter-end.

 

   

For money market funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of month-end are posted on the Columbia Funds’ website on a monthly basis, approximately five business days after such month-end. Commencing with the month-end holdings as of September 2010 and thereafter, such month-end holdings will be continuously available on the website for at least six months, together with a link to an SEC webpage where a user of the website may obtain access to the fund’s most recent 12 months of publicly available filings on Form N-MFP. Additionally, as of September 2010 and thereafter, money market fund portfolio holdings information posted on the website will, at minimum, include with respect to each holding, the name of the issuer, the category of investment (e.g., Treasury debt, government agency debt, asset backed commercial paper, structured investment vehicle note), the CUSIP number (if any), the principal amount, the maturity date (as determined under Rule 2a-7 for purposes of calculating weighted average maturity), the final maturity date (if different from the maturity date previously described), coupon or yield and the amortized cost value. The money market funds will also disclose on the website the overall weighted average maturity and weighted average life maturity of a holding.

The Adviser makes publicly available information regarding certain Columbia Fund’s largest five to fifteen holdings, as a percent of the market value of the Columbia Funds’ portfolios as of a month-end. This holdings information is made publicly available through the website generally no earlier than fifteen (15) days following the month-end.

The Adviser may also disclose more current portfolio holdings information as of specified dates on the Columbia Funds’ website.

The scope of the information that is made available on the Columbia Funds’ website pursuant to the Columbia Funds’ policies relating to a Columbia Fund’s portfolio may change from time to time without prior notice. The Columbia Funds file their portfolio holdings with the SEC for each fiscal quarter on Form N-CSR (with respect to each annual period and semi-annual period) and Form N-Q (with respect to the first and third quarters of each Columbia Fund’s fiscal year). Shareholders may obtain each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, a link to which is provided on the Columbia Funds’ website. In addition, each Columbia Fund’s Form N-CSR and N-Q filings may be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s public reference room in Washington, D.C. You may call the SEC at 202.551.8090 for information about the SEC’s website or the operation of the public reference room.

The Columbia Funds, the Adviser and their affiliates may include portfolio holdings information that already has been made public through a website posting or SEC filing in marketing literature and other communications to shareholders, advisors or other parties, provided that the information is disclosed no earlier than the business day after the date the information is disclosed publicly on the Columbia Funds’ website or no earlier than the time a Columbia Fund files such information in a publicly available SEC filing required to include such information.

Other Disclosures

The Columbia Funds’ policies and procedures provide that no disclosures of the Columbia Funds’ portfolio holdings may be made prior to the portfolio holdings information being made public unless (i) the Columbia Funds have a legitimate business purpose for making such disclosure, (ii) the Columbia Funds’ President authorizes such non-public disclosure of information, and (iii) the party receiving the non-public information enters into an appropriate confidentiality agreement or is otherwise subject to a confidentiality obligation.

 

54


Table of Contents

 

In determining the existence of a legitimate business purpose for making portfolio disclosures, the following factors, among others, are considered: (i) any prior disclosure must be consistent with the anti-fraud provisions of the federal securities laws and the fiduciary duties of the Adviser; (ii) any conflicts of interest between the interests of Columbia Fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the Adviser, the Distributor or any affiliated person of a Columbia Fund, on the other; and (iii) any prior disclosure to a third party, although subject to a confidentiality agreement, would not make conduct lawful that otherwise is unlawful.

In addition, the Columbia Funds periodically disclose their portfolio information on a confidential basis to various service providers that require such information to assist the Columbia Funds with their day-to-day business affairs. In addition to the Adviser and its affiliates, these service providers include each Columbia Fund’s subadviser(s) (if any), the Columbia Funds’ custodian, sub-custodians, independent registered public accounting firm, legal counsel, financial printers, proxy solicitor and proxy voting service provider, as well as ratings agencies that maintain ratings on certain Columbia Funds. These service providers are required to keep such information confidential, and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information except as necessary in providing services to the Columbia Funds. The Columbia Funds also may disclose portfolio holdings information to broker/dealers and certain other entities in connection with potential transactions and management of the Columbia Funds, provided that reasonable precautions, including limitations on the scope of the portfolio holdings information disclosed, are taken to avoid any potential misuse of the disclosed information.

Each Columbia Fund’s Board has adopted policies to ensure that the Columbia Fund’s holdings information is only disclosed in accordance with these policies. Before any selective disclosure of holdings information is permitted, the person seeking to disclose such holdings information must submit a written request to the Portfolio Holdings Committee (“PHC”). The PHC is comprised of members from the Adviser’s legal department, the Adviser’s compliance department, and the Columbia Funds’ President. The PHC has been authorized by each Columbia Fund’s Board to perform an initial review of requests for disclosure of holdings information to evaluate whether there is a legitimate business purpose for selective disclosure, whether selective disclosure is in the best interests of a fund and its shareholders, to consider any potential conflicts of interest between the fund, the investment adviser, and its affiliates, and to safeguard against improper use of holdings information. Factors considered in this analysis are whether the recipient has agreed to or has a duty to keep the holdings information confidential and whether risks have been mitigated such that the recipient has agreed or has a duty to use the holdings information only as necessary to effectuate the purpose for which selective disclosure was authorized, including a duty not to trade on such information. Before portfolio holdings may be selectively disclosed, requests approved by the PHC must also be authorized by either the Columbia Fund’s President, Chief Compliance Officer or General Counsel or their respective designees. On at least an annual basis, the PHC reviews the approved recipients of selective disclosure and may require a resubmission of the request, in order to re-authorize certain ongoing arrangements. These procedures are intended to be reasonably designed to protect the confidentiality of fund holdings information and to prohibit their release to individual investors, institutional investors, intermediaries that distribute the Columbia Funds’ shares, and other parties, until such holdings information is made public or unless such persons have been authorized to receive such holdings information on a selective basis, as set forth above.

 

55


Table of Contents

 

The Columbia Funds currently have ongoing arrangements with certain approved recipients with respect to the disclosure of portfolio holdings information prior to such information being made public. Portfolio holdings information disclosed to such recipients is current as of the time of its disclosure, is disclosed to each recipient solely for purposes consistent with the services described below and has been authorized by the Columbia Funds’ President. These special arrangements are described in the table below.

Ongoing Portfolio Holdings Disclosure Arrangements

 

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
    

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS ON
USE OF INFORMATION

   FREQUENCY OF
DISCLOSURE

Standard & Poor’s

     None       Use to maintain ratings for certain money market funds.    Weekly

InvestorTools, Inc.

     None       Access granted solely for the purpose of testing back office conversion of trading systems.    Real time

ING Insurance Company

     None       Access granted for specific Columbia Funds for ING’s creation of client/shareholder materials. ING may not distribute materials until the holdings information is made public.    Quarterly

Glass-Lewis & Co.

     None       Access in connection with testing the firm’s proxy services.    Daily

CMS Bondedge

     None       Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with application used by the Adviser’s Fixed Income Portfolio Management team as an analytical and trading tool.    Ad hoc

Linedata Services, Inc.

     None       Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with the software for the LongView Trade Order Management System.    Ad hoc

JP Morgan

     None       Access to provide the Adviser’s High Yield portfolio management team with peer group analysis reports for purposes of analyzing the portfolio.    Monthly

Malaspina Communications

     None       Use to facilitate writing, publishing and mailing Columbia Fund shareholder reports and communications including shareholder letters and management’s discussion of Columbia Fund performance.    Quarterly

Evare LLP

     None       Use for standardizing and reformatting data according to the Adviser’s specifications for use in the reconciliation process.    Daily

 

56


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
    

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS ON
USE OF INFORMATION

   FREQUENCY OF
DISCLOSURE

FactSet Research Systems, Inc.

     None       Use for provision of quantitative analytics, charting and fundamental data to the Adviser and Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
RR Donnelley/WE Andrews      None       Access as printers for the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs, fact sheets and brochures.    Monthly
Merrill Corporation      None       Use to provide fulfillment of the Columbia Funds’ prospectuses, supplements, SAIs and sales materials.    Monthly
Citigroup      None       Access when assisting in resolving technical difficulties with Yield Book, an analytic software program that the Adviser uses to perform ongoing risk analysis and management of certain fixed income Columbia Funds and fixed income separately managed accounts.    Daily
Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS)      None       Proxy voting administration and research on proxy matters utilized by MacKay Shields LLC, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds.    Daily
Cogent Consulting LLC      None       Utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds, to facilitate the evaluation of commission rates and to provide flexible commission reporting.    Daily
Moody’s      None       Ongoing portfolio surveillance for ratings it maintains on certain money market funds.    Monthly
Kynex      None       Use to provide portfolio attribution reports.    Daily
Bowne & Co.      None       Use for printing of the following materials: prospectuses, supplements and SAIs.    Monthly/
quarterly
Bloomberg      None       Use for portfolio analytics.    Daily
Barclays Point      None       Use for analytics including risk and attribution assessment.    Daily
Broadridge Financial Solutions, Inc.      None       Proxy voting and research utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds.    Daily

 

57


Table of Contents

IDENTITY OF RECIPIENT

   COMPENSATION/
CONSIDERATION
RECEIVED
    

CONDITIONS/RESTRICTIONS ON
USE OF INFORMATION

   FREQUENCY OF
DISCLOSURE
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Macgregor)      None       Order management system utilized by Marsico, subadviser for certain Columbia Funds that stores trading data and is used for trading and compliance purposes.    Ad hoc
Advent/AXP      None       Portfolio accounting system utilized by Marsico, subadviser to certain Columbia Funds, for both portfolio accounting and internal recordkeeping purposes.    Ad hoc
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Plexus Group)      None       Evaluation and assessment of trading activity, execution and practices by the Adviser.    Five days
after
quarter-end
BANA and State Street      None       Credit analysis performed by lenders.    Ad hoc
State Street      None       Use to provide custodian services.    Real time
Lipper      None       Use to create metrics for board and executive management reporting, product and marketing analysis, and fund performance.    Daily
Morningstar, Inc.      None       Use for independent research and ranking of Columbia Funds.    Daily

 

58


Table of Contents

 

INVESTMENT ADVISORY AND OTHER SERVICES

The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly, RiverSource Investments, LLC) (the Adviser) is the investment adviser and administrator of the Funds. The Adviser is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial. Ameriprise Financial is located at 1099 Ameriprise Financial Center, Minneapolis, MN 55474. The Adviser is located at 100 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110. Prior to May 1, 2010, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (the Previous Adviser), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Bank of America, was the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator.

Services Provided

Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, the Adviser has contracted to furnish each Fund with investment research and advice. For these services, each Fund pays a monthly fee to the Adviser based on the average of the daily closing value of the total net assets of a Fund for such month. Under the Investment Management Services Agreement, any liability of the Adviser to the Trust, a Fund and/or its shareholders is limited to situations involving the Adviser’s own willful misfeasance, bad faith, negligence in the performance of its duties or reckless disregard of its obligations and duties.

The Investment Management Services Agreement may be terminated with respect to a Fund at any time on 60 days’ written notice by the Adviser or by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund. The Investment Management Services Agreement will automatically terminate upon any assignment thereof, will continue in effect for two years from May 1, 2010 and thereafter will continue from year to year with respect to a Fund only so long as such continuance is approved at least annually (i) by the Trustees of the Trust or by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund and (ii) by vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as such term is defined in the 1940 Act) of the Adviser or the Trust, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval.

The Adviser pays all compensation of the Trustees and officers of the Trust who are employees of the Adviser, except for the Chief Compliance Officer, a portion of whose salary is paid by the Columbia Funds. Except to the extent expressly assumed by the Adviser and except to the extent required by law to be paid or reimbursed by the Adviser, the Adviser does not have a duty to pay any Fund operating expense incurred in the organization and operation of a Fund, including, but not limited to, auditing, legal, custodial, investor servicing and shareholder reporting expenses. The Trust pays the cost of printing and mailing Fund prospectuses to shareholders.

The Adviser, at its own expense, provides office space, facilities and supplies, equipment and personnel for the performance of its functions under each Fund’s Investment Management Services Agreement.

Advisory Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

Each Fund pays the Adviser an annual fee for its investment advisory services, as set forth in the Investment Management Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Fees and Expenses of the Fund Annual Fund Operating Expenses in each Fund’s prospectuses. The fee is calculated as a percentage of the average daily net assets of each Fund and is paid monthly. The Adviser also may pay amounts from its own assets to the Distributor and/or to selling and/or servicing agents for services they provide.

 

59


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser receives a monthly investment advisory fee based on each Fund’s average daily net assets at the following annual rates:

 

Fund

   First $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $1.5
billion
    Next $3
billion
    In excess
of $6
billion
 

Bond Fund

     0.65     0.35     0.32     0.29     0.28     0.27

Contrarian Core Fund

     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.53     0.51

Corporate Income Fund

     0.42     0.375     0.37     0.34     0.33     0.32

Dividend Income Fund

     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55     0.53     0.51

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     0.60     0.60     0.52     0.47     0.45     0.43

Intermediate Bond Fund

     0.35     0.35     0.30     0.29     0.28     0.27

Pacific/Asia Fund

     0.75     0.75     0.67     0.62     0.57     0.52

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     0.75     0.75     0.52     0.47     0.45     0.43

 

Fund

   All
assets
 

Balanced Fund

     0.50

Real Estate Equity Fund

     0.75

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     0.10

 

Fund

   First $1
billion
    Next $2
billion
    In excess
of $3
billion
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     0.50     0.45     0.40

 

Fund

   First
$500
million
    Next
$500
million
    Next
$500
million
    In excess
of $1.5
billion
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.52     0.49

International Bond Fund

     0.55     0.50     0.47     0.44

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     0.82     0.75     0.72     0.67

Strategic Income Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.52     0.49

 

Fund

   First $750
million
    Next $250
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $1.5
billion
    Next $3
billion
    In excess
of $6
billion
 

Emerging Markets Fund

     1.15     1.00     0.67     0.62     0.57     0.52

 

Fund

   First $100
million
    Next $100
million
    In excess
of $200
million
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

     0.450     0.425     0.400

 

Fund

   First $200
million
    Next $300
million
    In excess
of $500
million
 

Large Cap Growth Fund

     0.700     0.575     0.450

 

Fund

   First $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $500
million
    Next $500
million
    In excess
of $2
billion
 

Small Cap Core Fund

     0.75     0.70     0.65     0.60     0.55

 

60


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   First $500
million
    Next $500
million
    In excess
of $1
billion
 

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     0.87     0.82     0.77

Small Cap Value Fund I

     0.80     0.75     0.70

Strategic Investor Fund

     0.60     0.55     0.50

 

Fund

   First $10
billion
    In excess
of $10
billion
 

Value and Restructuring Fund

     0.60     0.43

Advisory Fees Paid by the Funds

The Adviser and the Previous Adviser received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show the advisory fees paid to and, as applicable, waived/reimbursed by the Adviser and the Previous Adviser, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,555,388       $ 3,357,269       $ 3,573,130   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 1,762,911       $ 968,294       $ 981,002   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,172,793       $ 2,165,208       $ 2,762,711   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 4,059,904       $ 6,822,851       $ 15,695,279   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 133,614       $ 710,637         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,382,995       $ 3,524,919       $ 4,061,431   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 6,768,041       $ 7,167,840       $ 7,648,763   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 219,007       $ 634,182       $ 1,872,501   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 131,463       $ 37,003         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 10,061,635       $ 7,032,799       $ 6,446,350   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 374,018       $ 360,167       $ 183,771   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 659,969       $ 380,634       $ 163,118   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

61


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 38,153,435       $ 45,997,660       $ 54,318,105   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

High Yield Opportunity Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 167,714       $ 1,881,734       $ 1,848,657       $ 2,186,530   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 57,327       $ 83,858         —         $ 19,549   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Income Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

     $949,914         $10,224,619       $ 9,937,336       $ 10,213,556   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended  

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser      May 31, 2009*  

International Bond Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 7,487       $ 69,573       $ 20,485   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 25,747       $ 124,507       $ 142,545   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year  Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

High Yield Municipal Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 524,787       $ 2,361,306       $ 2,421,629       $ 3,036,689   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,883,799       $ 7,793,816       $ 6,138,109       $ 7,336,126   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

Balanced Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 516,594       $ 875,889       $ 884,961       $ 1,038,397   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

62


Table of Contents
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Adviser      Previous Adviser        

Mid Cap Growth Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,977,727       $ 5,939,170       $ 7,193,675       $ 11,479,270   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Growth Fund I

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,371,009       $ 4,158,194       $ 3,216,309       $ 2,697,664   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —         $ 109,017         —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Investor Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 1,486,665       $ 3,136,677       $ 4,131,661       $ 6,613,337   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 407,410       $ 989,742       $ 1,606,165       $ 294,451   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

*

All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 2,110,310       $ 2,721,935       $ 3,104,656   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 318,233       $ 382,426       $ 411,079   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Dividend Income Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 8,227,244       $ 7,520,664       $ 7,151,747   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 791,034       $ 591,255       $ 725,253   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 5,877,711       $ 8,656,167       $ 9,179,749   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 3,382,545       $ 6,765,818       $ 9,376,432   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 462,542       $ 524,477       $ 588,869   

Amount Reimbursed

   $ 157,165       $ 160,592       $ 158,586   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Advisory Fee Paid

   $ 686,031       $ 1,670,236       $ 2,487,144       $ 4,576,982   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Adviser.

 

63


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio Manager(s)

The following provides additional information about the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for making the day-to-day investment decisions for the Funds. As described in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the portfolio manager(s) of the Adviser who are responsible for the Funds are:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Leonard A. Aplet, CFA    Balanced Fund
Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I
Robert B. Cameron    Emerging Markets Fund

Catherine Stienstra

   Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund
Richard A. Carter    Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Wayne M. Collette, CFA   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Richard E. Dahlberg, CFA    Dividend Income Fund
Richard G. D’Auteuil    Small Cap Core Fund
Scott L. Davis    Dividend Income Fund
Peter R. Deininger    Large Cap Growth Fund
Chad H. Farrington, CFA    High Yield Municipal Fund
William Finan    U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Thomas M. Galvin, CFA    Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Emil A. Gjester    Strategic Investor Fund
Todd D. Herget    Select Large Cap Growth Fund
Jeffrey Hershey, CFA    Small Cap Core Fund
Michael E. Hoover    Energy and Natural Resources Fund
Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFM   

Emerging Markets Fund

Pacific/Asia Fund

Arthur J. Hurley, CFA    Real Estate Equity Fund
Orhan Imer, PhD, CFA    U.S. Treasury Index Fund
Jeremy Javidi, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I
Brian Lavin, CFA   

Balanced Fund

Corporate Income Fund

High Yield Opportunity Fund

Intermediate Bond Fund

Strategic Income Fund

Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Colin J. Lundgren, CFA    Strategic Income Fund
George J. Myers, CFA   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Brian D. Neigut   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

Small Cap Growth Fund I

Daisuke Nomoto, CMA (SAAJ)    Pacific/Asia Fund
Jonas Patrikson, CFA    Strategic Investor Fund
Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

Bond Fund

Corporate Income Fund

Intermediate Bond

Nicholas Pifer, CFA    International Bond Fund
Jennifer Ponce de Leon    High Yield Opportunity Fund
Guy W. Pope, CFA   

Balanced Fund

Contrarian Core Fund

Value and Restructuring Fund

 

64


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

Alexander D. Powers   

Bond Fund

Intermediate Bond Fund

J. Nicholas Smith, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund
Ronald B. Stahl, CFA    Balanced Fund
Gene R. Tannuzzo, CFA    Strategic Income Fund
Mary-Ann Ward    Strategic Investor Fund
Michael T. Welter, CFA    Strategic Investor Fund
Dara J. White, CFA    Emerging Markets Fund
David J. Williams, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund
John T. Wilson, CFA    Large Cap Growth Fund
Michael Zazzarino   

Bond Fund

Intermediate Bond Fund

Portfolio Manager(s) Information

The following table provides information about each Fund’s portfolio manager(s) as of the end of the Fund’s most recent fiscal year, or as indicated, the most recent practicable date including the number and amount of assets of other investment accounts (or portions of investment accounts) that the portfolio manager(s) managed.

         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

         

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

Bond Fund    Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

5 RICs

3 other accounts

  

$5.65 billion

$850,000

   None    None    (1)
   Alexander D. Powers   

2 RICs

7 PIVs

17 other accounts

  

$2.79 billion

$2.1 billion

$1.1 billion

   None   

$10,001- $50,000a

$1- 10,000b

   (1)
   Michael Zazzarino   

5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  

$4.193 billion

$2.636 billion

$192.2 million

   None    None    (1)
Corporate Income Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA1   

2 RICs

1 PIV

4 other accounts

  

$2.92 billion

$9.56 million

$766.77 million

   None    None    (2)
   Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

4 RICs

3 other accounts

  

$5.1 billion

$850,000

   None    None    (1)
Emerging Markets Fund    Robert B. Cameron   

1 PIV

5 other accounts

  

$61.4 million

$930,000

   None    $1- $10,000b    (1)
   Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFM   

7 RICs

4 PIVs

4 other accounts

  

$646.2 million

$634.7 million

$200,000

   None    None    (1)
   Dara J. White, CFA   

1 PIV

9 other accounts

  

$61.4 million

$405,000

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$10,001- $50,000b

   (1)
Energy and Natural Resources Fund    Michael E. Hoover   

3 PIVs

3 other accounts

  

$689.7 million

$741,342

   None    None    (1)
Intermediate Bond Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA1   

2 RICs

1 PIV

4 other accounts

  

$2.92 billion

$9.56 million

$766.77 million

   None    None    (2)

 

65


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

         

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
   Carl W. Pappo, CFA   

4 RICs

3 other accounts

  

$3.45 billion

$850,000

   None    $50,001- $100,000a    (1)
   Alexander D. Powers   

3 RICs

7 PIVs

17 other accounts

  

$3.4 billion

$2.1 billion

$1.1 billion

   None    None    (1)
   Michael Zazzarino   

5 RICs

9 PIVs

9 other accounts

  

$2.61 billion

$2.64 billion

$192.2 million

   None    None    (1)
Pacific/Asia Fund    Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFM   

7 RICs

4 PIVs

4 other accounts

  

$1.02 billion

$634.7 million

$200,000

   None    None    (1)
   Daisuke Nomoto, CMA (SAAJ)   

4 RICs

3 PIVs

2 other accounts

  

$490.8 million

$578.7 million

$200,000

   None    None    (1)
Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Richard A. Carter   

1 RIC

1 PIV

2,389 other accounts

  

$4 million

$43 million

$1.5 billion

   1 Other ($175 M)   

$50,001- $100,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)
   Thomas M. Galvin, CFA   

1 RIC

1 PIV

2,389 other accounts

  

$4 million

$43 million

$1.5 billion

   1 Other ($175 M)    Over $1,000,000    (1)
   Todd D. Herget   

1 PIV

2,389 other accounts

  

$43 million

$1.5 billion

   1 Other ($175 M)    $50,001- $100,000a    (1)
U.S. Treasury Index Fund    William Finan    5 other accounts    $1 million    None    None    (1)
   Orhan Imer, PhD, CFA    6 other accounts    $150,000    None    None    (1)
Value and Restructuring Fund    Guy W. Pope, CFA   

5 RICs

1,927 other accounts

  

$1.76 billion

$2.29 billion

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)
   J. Nicholas Smith, CFA   

3 RICs

1,883 other accounts

  

$924.6 million

$2.01 billion

   None    $10,001- $50,000a    (1)
   David J. Williams, CFA   

3 RICs

1,919 other accounts

  

$924.6 million

$2.08 billion

   None    $100,001- $500,000a    (1)

For Funds with fiscal year ending May 31

High Yield Opportunity Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA   

12 RICs

1 PIV

3 other accounts

  

$10.312 billion

$9.331 million

$683.335 million

   None    None    (2)
   Jennifer Ponce de Leon   

12 RICs

1 PIV

27 other accounts

  

$17.640 billion

$9.331 million

$4.578 million

   None    None    (2)
International Bond Fund    Nicholas Pifer, CFA2   

5 RICs

4 PIV

17 other accounts

  

$5.05 billion

$113.33 million

$4.62 billion

   None    None    (2)
Strategic Income Fund    Brian Lavin, CFA   

12 RICs

1 PIV

3 other accounts

  

$8.61 billion

$9.331 million

$683.335 million

   None    None    (2)
   Colin J. Lundgren, CFA   

21 RICs

9 other accounts

  

$40.761 billion

$274.15 million

  

2 RICs

($527.4 M)

   None    (2)
   Gene R. Tannuzzo, CFA   

10 RICs

2 other accounts

  

$25.657 billion

$0.08 million

   None       (2)

 

66


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

         

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)

For Funds with fiscal year ending June 30

High Yield Municipal Fund    Chad H. Farrington    8 other accounts    $194,000    None    $1-$10,000b    (1)
Small Cap Value Fund I    Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA   

5 RICs

1 PIV

13 other accounts

  

$433 million

$30 million

$57 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$10,001 - $50,000b

   (1)
   Jeremy Javidi, CFA   

5 RICs

1 PIV

14 other accounts

  

$433 million

$30 million

$54 million

   None   

$100,001- $500,000a

$1 - $10,000b

   (1)

For Funds with fiscal year ending August 31

Balanced Fund    Leonard A. Aplet, CFA   

10 RICs

8 PIVs

85 other accounts

  

$2.8 billion

$3.555 billion

$10.9 billion

   None    $10,001 - $50,000 a    (1)
   Brian Lavin, CFA   

12 RICs

1 PIV

3 other accounts

  

$9.907 billion

$10.48 million

$684.84 million

   None    None    (2)
   Guy W. Pope, CFA   

4 RICs

1,825 other accounts

  

$6.976 billion

$1.007 billion

   None    $100,001 - $500,000 a    (1)
   Ronald B. Stahl, CFA   

10 RICs

6 PIVs

53 other accounts

  

$2.8 billion

$785.7 million

$3.879 billion

   None    $10,001 - $50,000 a    (1)
Mid Cap Growth Fund    Wayne M. Collette, CFA   

9 RICs

2 PIVs

191 other accounts

  

$1.5 billion

$168.61 million

$240 million

   None    $10,001 - $50,000b    (1)
   Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.178 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None    $1- $10,000    (1)
   George J. Myers, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

182 other accounts

  

$1.178 billion

$168.61 million

$178.6 million

   None   

$10,001 - $50,000 a

$10,001 - $50,000 b

   (1)
   Brian D. Neigut   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.178 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)
Small Cap Growth Fund I    Wayne M. Collette, CFA   

9 RICs

2 PIVs

191 other accounts

  

$1.8 billion

$168.61 million

$240 million

   None    $10,001 - $50,000b    (1)
   Lawrence W. Lin, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.479 billion

$168.61 million

$178.8 million

   None    $1- $10,000    (1)
   George J. Myers, CFA   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

182 other accounts

  

$1.479 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None   

$10,001 - $50,000 a

$10,001 - $50,000 b

   (1)
   Brian D. Neigut   

7 RICs

2 PIVs

184 other accounts

  

$1.479 billion

$168.61 million

$178.61 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1- $10,000b

   (1)

 

67


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the Fund)

           

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net
Assets

  

Performance
Based
Accounts

  

Dollar
Range of
Equity
Securities
in the Fund
Beneficially
Owned

   Structure of
Compensation
(described in
next
sub-section)
 
Strategic Investor Fund    Emil A. Gjester   

1 RIC

1 PIV

289 other accounts

  

$89.65 million

$201.32 million

$220.38 million

   None   

$100,001 - $500,000 a

$10,001 - $50,000 b

     (1)   
   Jonas Patrikson, CFA   

1 RIC

1 PIV

282 other accounts

  

$89.648 million

$201.32 million

$220.22 million

   None   

$1- $10,000a

$1-$10,000b

     (1)   
   Mary-Ann Ward   

1 RIC

1 PIV

293 other accounts

  

$89.65 million

$201.32 million

$227.68 million

   None    None      (1)   
   Michael T. Welter, CFA   

1 RIC

1 PIV

283 other accounts

  

89.65 billion

$201.3 million

$220.6 million

   None   

$50,001- $100,000a

$1 - $10,000b

     (1)   

For Funds with fiscal year ending September 30

  
Contrarian Core Fund    Guy W. Pope, CFA   

3 RICs

1,847 other accounts

  

$6.6 billion

$567 million

   None   

$100,001- $500,000a

$10,001- $50,000b

     (1)   
Dividend Income Fund    Richard E. Dahlberg, CFA   

1 RIC

2 PIVs

99 other accounts

  

$425 million

$372 million

$813.01 million

   None   

$100,001- $500,000a

$100,001- $500,000b

     (1)   
   Scott L. Davis   

2 PIVs

92 other accounts

  

$372 million

$815 million

   None   

$50,001- $100,000a

$100,001- $500,000b

     (1)   
Large Cap Growth Fund    Peter R. Deininger3   

1 PIV

15 other accounts

  

$315 million

$275 million

   None    $1- $10,000      (1)   
   John T. Wilson, CFA   

4 RICs

1 PIV

19 other accounts

  

$200 million

$300 million

$500 million

   None    $100,001- $500,000a      (1)   
Small Cap Core Fund    Richard D’Auteuil   

1 PIV

27 other accounts

  

$158.85 million

$907.08 million

   None    None      (1)   
   Jeffrey Hershey, CFA   

1 PIV

28 other accounts

  

$158.85 million

$901.77 million

   None    None      (1)   

For the Fund with fiscal year ending October 31

  
Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund    Catherine Stienstra4   

11 RICs

12 other accounts

  

$4.42 billion

$6.68 billion

   None    None      (2)   

For the Fund with fiscal period ending December 31

  
Real Estate Equity Fund    Arthur J. Hurley, CFA    8 other accounts    $750,000    None   

$1-$10,000a

$1-$10,000b

     (1)   

 

*

RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.

a

Excludes any notional investments.

b

Notional investments through a deferred compensation account.

1

Information provided as of April 30, 2010.

2

Account information provided as of May 31, 2010. Other accounts also include personal accounts as of June 30, 2010.

3

Account information provided as of March 31, 2010.

4

Account information provided as of August 31, 2010.

 

68


Table of Contents

 

Structure of Compensation

(1) Compensation of Legacy Columbia Management Advisors, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of the Previous Adviser prior to May 1, 2010, is typically paid in the form of salary, bonus, stock options, restricted stock and notional investments through an incentive plan, the value of which is measured by reference to the performance of the Columbia Funds in which the account is invested. The bonus for these portfolio managers is variable and generally is based on (1) an evaluation of the portfolio manager’s investment performance and (2) the results of a peer and/or management review of the portfolio manager, which takes into account skills and attributes such as team participation, investment process, communication and professionalism. In evaluating investment performance, the Adviser generally considers the one, three and five year performance of mutual funds and other accounts managed by the portfolio manager relative to the benchmarks and peer groups noted below, emphasizing the portfolio manager’s three and five year performance. The Adviser also may consider a portfolio manager’s performance in managing client assets in sectors and industries assigned to the portfolio manager as part of his/her investment team responsibilities, when applicable. For portfolio managers who also have group management responsibilities, another factor in their evaluation is an assessment of the group’s overall investment performance. The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

(2) Compensation of Legacy RiverSource Investments, LLC Portfolio Managers

Compensation for portfolio managers who were associates of RiverSource Investments, LLC (now known as Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC), is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, and (ii) an annual cash bonus, a portion of which may be subject to a mandatory deferral program, and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The Adviser’s portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Adviser employees. Depending upon their job level, Adviser portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Adviser employees at the same job level.

The annual cash bonus is paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by the aggregate market competitive bonus targets for the teams of which the portfolio manager is a member and by the short-term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to applicable benchmarks or the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of the Adviser has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team.

The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the Adviser’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

 

69


Table of Contents

 

Performance Benchmarks

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Leonard A. Aplet,

CFA

   Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
Stephen D. Barbaro, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Classification

Catherine Stienstra

   Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund    Barclays Capital Municipal Bond Index    Lipper Connecticut Municipal Debt Funds Classification
Robert B. Cameron    Emerging Markets Fund    MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Net); MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Gross); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Classification
Richard A. Carter    Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Wayne M. Collette, CFA    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Richard E. Dahlberg, CFA    Dividend Income Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Equity Income Funds Classification
Richard D’Auteuil    Small Cap Core Fund    Russell 2000 Index; S&P Small Cap 600 Composite Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification
Scott L. Davis    Dividend Income Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Equity Income Funds Classification
Peter R. Deininger    Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Chad H. Farrington    High Yield Municipal Fund    Barclays Capital High Yield Municipal Bond Index; Blended Benchmark4    Lipper High Yield Municipal Debt Funds Classification
William Finan    U.S. Treasury Index Fund    Citigroup Bond U.S. Treasury Index    Lipper General U.S. Treasury Funds Classification
Thomas M. Galvin, CFA    Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

70


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Emil A. Gjester    Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
Todd D. Herget    Select Large Cap Growth Fund    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Jeffrey Hershey, CFA    Small Cap Core Fund    Russell 2000 Index; S&P Small Cap 600 Composite Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification
Michael E. Hoover    Energy and Natural Resources Fund    S&P North American Natural Resources Sector Index    Lipper Natural Resources Funds Classification
Jasmine (Weili) Huang, CFA, CPA (U.S. and China), CFA    Emerging Markets Fund    MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Net); MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Gross); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Classification
   Pacific/Asia Fund    MSCI AC Asia Pacific Index (Net); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Pacific Region Funds Classification
Arthur J. Hurley, CFA    Real Estate Equity Fund    FTSE NAREIT Equity REITs Index    Lipper Real Estate Funds Classification
Orhan Imer    U.S. Treasury Index Fund    Citigroup Bond U.S. Treasury Index    Lipper General U.S. Treasury Funds Classification
Jeremy Javidi, CFA    Small Cap Value Fund I    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Classification
Brian Lavin, CFA    Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   Corporate Income Fund   

Barclays Capital Credit Bond Index;

Blended Benchmark2

   Lipper Corporate Debt Funds BBB Rated Classification
   High Yield Opportunity Fund    JPMorgan Global High Yield Index; Credit Suisse High Yield Index   

Lipper High Current Yield

Funds Classification

   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification
   Strategic Income Fund    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index; Blended Benchmark3    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification
Lawrence W. Lin, CFA    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

71


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Colin J. Lundgren, CFA    Strategic Income Fund    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index; Blended Benchmark3    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification
George J. Myers, CFA    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Brian D. Neigut    Mid Cap Growth Fund    Russell MidCap Growth Index; Russell MidCap Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Small Cap Growth Fund I    Russell 2000 Index; Russell 2000 Growth Index    Lipper Small-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Daisuke Nomoto, CMA (SAAJ)    Pacific/Asia Fund    MSCI AC Asia Pacific Index (Net); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Pacific Region Funds Classification
Carl. W. Pappo, CFA    Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Corporate Debt Funds A Rated Classification
   Corporate Income Fund   

Barclays Capital Credit Bond Index;

Blended Benchmark2

   Lipper Corporate Debt Funds BBB Rated Classification
   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification
Jonas Patrikson, CFA    Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
Nicholas Pifer    International Bond Fund    Citigroup Non-U.S. Dollar World Government Bond Index- Unhedged    Lipper International Income Funds Classification
Jennifer Ponce de Leon    High Yield Opportunity Fund    JPMorgan Global High Yield Index; Credit Suisse High Yield Index   

Lipper High Current Yield

Funds Classification

Guy W. Pope, CFA    Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification

 

72


Table of Contents

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Primary Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

   Contrarian Core Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Classification
   Value and Restructuring Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index; S&P 500 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification
Alexander D. Powers    Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Corporate Debt Funds A Rated Classification
   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification
J. Nicholas Smith, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index; S&P 500 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification
Ronald B. Stahl, CFA    Balanced Fund    S&P 500 Index; Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index; Blended Benchmark1    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
Gene R. Tannuzzo, CFA    Strategic Income Fund    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index; Blended Benchmark3    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification
Mary-Ann Ward    Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification

Michael T. Welter,

CFA

   Strategic Investor Fund    Russell 1000 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Core Funds Classification
Dara J. White   

Emerging Markets

Fund

   MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Net); MSCI Emerging Markets Index (Gross); MSCI EAFE Index (Net)    Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Classification
David J. Williams, CFA    Value and Restructuring Fund    Russell 1000 Value Index; S&P 500 Index    Lipper Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification
John T. Wilson, CFA    Large Cap Growth Fund   

Russell 1000 Growth

Index

   Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification
Michael Zazzarino    Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Corporate Debt Funds A Rated Classification
   Intermediate Bond Fund    Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Intermediate Investment Grade Debt Funds Classification

 

1

A custom composite, established by the Adviser, consisting of a 60% weighting of the S&P 500 Index and a 40% weighting of the Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index.

2

A weighted custom composite of the Barclays Capital U.S. Credit Bond Index (85%) and JP Morgan Global High Yield Index (15%) established by the Adviser.

3

A custom composite, established by the Adviser, consisting of a 35% weighting of the Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index, a 35% weighting of the JPMorgan Global High Yield Index, a 15% weighting of the Citigroup Non-U.S. World Government Bond Index – Unhedged and a 15% weighting of the JPMorgan EMBI Global Diversified Index.

4

A custom composite, established by the Adviser, consisting of a 60% weighting of the Barclays Capital High Yield Municipal Bond Index and a 40% weighting of the Barclays Capital Municipal Bond Index.

 

73


Table of Contents

 

The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interest

Like other investment professionals with multiple clients, a Fund’s portfolio manager(s) may face certain potential conflicts of interest in connection with managing both the Fund and other accounts at the same time. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance policies and procedures that attempt to address certain of the potential conflicts that portfolio managers face in this regard. Certain of these conflicts of interest are summarized below.

The management of accounts with different advisory fee rates and/or fee structures, including accounts that pay advisory fees based on account performance (performance fee accounts), may raise potential conflicts of interest for a portfolio manager by creating an incentive to favor higher fee accounts.

Potential conflicts of interest also may arise when a portfolio manager has personal investments in other accounts that may create an incentive to favor those accounts. As a general matter and subject to the Adviser’s Code of Ethics and certain limited exceptions, the Adviser’s investment professionals do not have the opportunity to invest in client accounts, other than the Funds. A portfolio manager who is responsible for managing multiple funds and/or accounts may devote unequal time and attention to the management of those funds and/or accounts. The effects of this potential conflict may be more pronounced where funds and/or accounts managed by a particular portfolio manager have different investment strategies.

A portfolio manager may be able to select or influence the selection of the broker/dealers that are used to execute securities transactions for the Funds. A portfolio manager’s decision as to the selection of broker/dealers could produce disproportionate costs and benefits among the Funds and the other accounts the portfolio manager manages.

A potential conflict of interest may arise when a portfolio manager buys or sells the same securities for a Fund and other accounts. On occasions when a portfolio manager considers the purchase or sale of a security to be in the best interests of a Fund as well as other accounts, the Adviser’s trading desk may, to the extent consistent with applicable laws and regulations, aggregate the securities to be sold or bought in order to obtain the best execution and lower brokerage commissions, if any. Aggregation of trades may create the potential for unfairness to a Fund or another account if a portfolio manager favors one account over another in allocating the securities bought or sold.

“Cross trades,” in which a portfolio manager sells a particular security held by a Fund to another account (potentially saving transaction costs for both accounts), could involve a potential conflict of interest if, for example, a portfolio manager is permitted to sell a security from one account to another account at a higher price than an independent third party would pay. The Adviser and the Funds have adopted compliance procedures that provide that any transactions between the Fund and another account managed by the Adviser are to be made at a current market price, consistent with applicable laws and regulations.

Another potential conflict of interest may arise based on the different investment objectives and strategies of a Fund and other accounts managed by its portfolio manager(s). Depending on another account’s objectives and other factors, a portfolio manager may give advice to and make decisions for a Fund that may differ from advice given, or the timing or nature of decisions made, with respect to another account. A portfolio manager’s investment decisions are the product of many factors in addition to basic suitability for the particular account involved. Thus, a portfolio manager may buy or sell a particular security for certain accounts, and not for a Fund, even though it could have been bought or sold for the Fund at the same time. A portfolio manager also may buy a particular security for one or more accounts when one or more other accounts are selling the security (including short sales). There may be circumstances when a portfolio manager’s purchases or sales of portfolio securities for one or more accounts may have an adverse effect on other accounts, including the Funds.

A Fund’s portfolio manager(s) also may have other potential conflicts of interest in managing the Fund, and the description above is not a complete description of every conflict that could exist in managing the Fund and

 

74


Table of Contents

other accounts. Many of the potential conflicts of interest to which the Adviser’s portfolio managers are subject are essentially the same or similar to the potential conflicts of interest related to the investment management activities of the Adviser and its affiliates. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

Manager of Managers Exemption

The SEC has issued an order that permits the Adviser, subject to the approval of the Board, to appoint an unaffiliated subadviser or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for a Fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits a Fund to add or to change unaffiliated subadvisers or to change the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change. The Adviser and its affiliates may have other relationships, including significant financial relationships, with current or potential subadvisers or their affiliates, which may create certain conflicts of interest. When making recommendations to the Board to appoint or to change a subadviser, or to change the terms of a subadvisory agreement, the Adviser discloses to the Board the nature of any material relationships it has with a subadviser or its affiliates.

The Administrator

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (which is also the Adviser) serves as Administrator of the Funds.

Services Provided

Pursuant to the terms of the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator has agreed to provide all of the services and facilities necessary for, or appropriate to, the business and effective operation of each Fund that are not (a) provided by employees or other agents engaged by each Fund or (b) required to be provided by any person pursuant to any other agreement or arrangement with each Fund.

Administration Fee Rates Paid by the Funds

The Administrator receives fees as compensation for its services, which are computed daily and paid monthly, as set forth in the Administrative Services Agreement, and as shown in the section entitled Primary Service Providers – The Administrator in each Fund’s prospectuses.

For U.S. Treasury Index Fund, pursuant to the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator, from the administration fee it receives from the Fund, pays all operating expenses of the Fund, except the fees and expenses of the Trustees who are not interested persons of the Administrator or its affiliates, brokerage fees and commissions, interest on borrowings and such extraordinary, non-recurring expenses as may arise, including litigation expenses. For the purposes of this arrangement, distribution and service fees are not considered operating expenses.

Administration Fees Paid by the Funds

The Administrator and the Previous Administrator received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show administration fees paid to and, as applicable, waived/reimbursed by the Administrator and the Previous Administrator, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

75


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 754,748       $ 678,588       $ 759,720   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 209,350       $ 206,179   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 675,315       $ 675,654       $ 870,923   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 615,027       $ 1,001,669       $ 2,430,055   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 251,476       $ 476,664   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 723,263       $ 765,650       $ 941,122   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 254,984       $ 263,577   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 3,164,565       $ 3,373,301       $ 3,620,050   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 16,020       $ 85,238       $ 334,900   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 30,445       $ 66,921   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 2,127,779       $ 1,291,853       $ 1,216,720   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 394,599       $ 333,294   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 1,122,055       $ 1,080,502       $ 551,345   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 9,398,359       $ 11,411,391       $ 13,588,716   

Amount Reimbursed

     —         $ 3,327,593       $ 3,424,080   

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year  Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
       

High Yield Opportunity Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Income Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

76


Table of Contents

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended
May 31, 2009*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
    

International Bond Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

     $680         $6,325       $ 1,862   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
       

High Yield Municipal Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 140,597       $ 637,176       $ 661,657       $ 815,422   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Fund

   Administrator      Previous
Administrator
       

Balanced Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Mid Cap Growth Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Growth Fund I

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

Strategic Investor Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     $382,478         $810,252       $ 1,058,644       $ 1,175,452   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.
1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 201,987       $ 260,528       $ 297,160   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

77


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Dividend Income Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 836,788       $ 756,060       $ 714,875   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 555,279       $ 865,130       $ 922,750   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

   $ 302,523       $ 625,431       $ 889,186   

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Administration Fee Paid

     N/A         N/A         N/A   

Amount Reimbursed

     N/A         N/A         N/A   

Amount Waived

     N/A         N/A         N/A   

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Administration Fee Paid

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Reimbursed

     —           —           —           —     

Amount Waived

     —           —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived/reimbursed by the Previous Administrator.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Services

State Street is responsible for providing certain pricing and bookkeeping services to the Funds. The Administrator is responsible for overseeing the performance of these services and for certain other services.

Services Provided

Effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into a Financial Reporting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (the Financial Reporting Services Agreement) pursuant to which State Street provides financial reporting services to the Funds. Also effective December 15, 2006, the Trust entered into an Accounting Services Agreement with State Street and the Previous Adviser (collectively with the Financial Reporting Services Agreement, the State Street Agreements) pursuant to which State Street provides accounting services to the Funds. Effective May 1, 2010, the State Street Agreements were amended to, among other things, assign and delegate the Previous Adviser’s rights and obligations under the State Street Agreements to the Administrator. Under the State Street Agreements, each Fund pays State Street an annual fee of $38,000 paid monthly plus an additional monthly fee based on an annualized percentage rate of average daily net assets of the Fund for the month. The aggregate fee for a Fund during any year shall not exceed $140,000 annually (exclusive of out-of-pocket expenses and charges). Each Fund also reimburses State Street for certain out-of-pocket expenses and charges.

 

78


Table of Contents

 

From December 15, 2006 through May 1, 2010, the Trust was party to a Pricing and Bookkeeping Oversight and Services Agreement (the Services Agreement) with the Previous Adviser. Under the Services Agreement, the Previous Adviser provided services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and provided oversight of the accounting and financial reporting services provided by State Street. Under the Services Agreement, each Fund reimbursed the Previous Adviser for out-of-pocket expenses and charges, including fees payable to third parties, such as for pricing the Funds’ portfolio securities, incurred by the Previous Adviser in the performance of services under the Services Agreement. Prior to January 1, 2008, the Funds also reimbursed the Previous Adviser for accounting oversight services and services related to Fund expenses and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Effective May 1, 2010, the services previously provided by the Previous Adviser under the Services Agreement began to be provided by the Administrator under the Administrative Services Agreement, and the Services Agreement was terminated. Under the Administrative Services Agreement, fees for pricing and bookkeeping services incurred by U.S. Treasury Index Fund are paid by the Administrator.

Prior to December 15, 2006, the Previous Adviser was responsible for providing pricing and bookkeeping services, to the Funds operating at the time, under a pricing and bookkeeping agreement and was entitled to receive an annual fee at the same rate described above under the State Street Agreements. Under separate agreements between the Previous Adviser and State Street, the Previous Adviser delegated certain functions to State Street. As a result of the delegation, the total fees payable under the pricing and bookkeeping agreement (other than certain reimbursements paid to the Previous Adviser and discussed below) were paid to State Street. The Funds also reimbursed the Previous Adviser for out-of-pocket expenses and charges, including fees payable to third parties for pricing the Funds’ portfolio securities and direct internal costs incurred by the Previous Adviser in connection with providing fund accounting oversight and monitoring and certain other services.

Pricing and Bookkeeping Fees Paid by the Funds

The Adviser and the Previous Adviser and State Street received fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show the net pricing and bookkeeping fees paid to State Street and to the Adviser and the Previous Adviser, as applicable, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 149,216       $ 129,842       $ 82,648   

Corporate Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,791   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 158,268       $ 156,839       $ 182,251   

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 103,288       $ 117,814       $ 105,826   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 123,403       $ 116,154       $ 78,072   

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 10,791   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 189,677       $ 188,898       $ 189,435   

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 53,504       $ 57,548       $ 52,002   

 

79


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 140,511       $ 140,065       $ 77,132   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund**

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

     —           —           —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 5,746   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 143,767       $ 143,296       $ 78,208   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.
** Under the Administrative Services Agreement, fees for pricing and bookkeeping services incurred by U.S. Treasury Index Fund are paid by the Administrator.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 114,926   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 113,154       $ 96,616       $ 8,212   

Strategic Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 190,423   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 193,287       $ 181,682       $ 8,212   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended
May 31, 2009*
 

International Bond Fund

     

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —     

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 46,735       $ 26,617   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 7,494   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 192,931       $ 180,290       $ 191,877   

Small Cap Value Fund I

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 7,494   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 146,364       $ 145,161       $ 143,111   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Balanced Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

     $97,492       $ 80,304       $ 85,084   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 145,095       $ 145,117       $ 144,122   

 

80


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 

Small Cap Growth Fund I

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 145,808       $ 97,227       $ 87,811   

Strategic Investor Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 147,864       $ 143,423       $ 149,889   

 

*

All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 43,283   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 83,251       $ 96,037       $ 78,321   

Dividend Income Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 51,635   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,429       $ 144,517       $ 103,692   

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 51,635   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 141,538       $ 140,096       $ 106,855   

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 3,106       $ 51,635   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 104,080       $ 152,060       $ 114,670   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —         $ 1,952       $ 24,798   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 61,643       $ 62,893       $ 56,215   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Amount Paid to Adviser

     —           —         $ 4,673       $ 63,096   

Amount Paid to State Street

   $ 27,743       $ 74,509       $ 84,454       $ 84,836   

 

* All amounts “Paid to Adviser” were paid to the Previous Adviser.

The Principal Underwriter/Distributor

Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (the Distributor) serves as the principal underwriter and distributor for the continuous offering of shares of the Funds pursuant to a Distribution Agreement. The Distribution Agreement obligates the Distributor to use appropriate efforts to find purchasers for the shares of the Funds. The Distributor’s address is: One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111.

Distribution Obligations

Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, as agent, sells shares of the Funds on a continuous basis and transmits purchase and redemption orders that it receives to the Trust or the Transfer Agent, or their

 

81


Table of Contents

designated agents. Additionally, the Distributor has agreed to use appropriate efforts to solicit orders for the sale of shares and to undertake advertising and promotion as it believes appropriate in connection with such solicitation. Pursuant to the Distribution Agreement, the Distributor, at its own expense, finances those activities which are primarily intended to result in the sale of shares of the Funds, including, but not limited to, advertising, compensation of underwriters, dealers and sales personnel, the printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than existing shareholders, and the printing and mailing of sales literature. The Distributor, however, may be compensated or reimbursed for all or a portion of such expenses to the extent permitted by a Distribution Plan adopted by the Trust pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Distribution and Servicing Plans for more information about the share classes for which the Trust has adopted a Distribution Plan.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about conflicts of interest, including those that relate to the Adviser and its affiliates.

The Distribution Agreement became effective with respect to each Fund after approval by its Board, and, after an initial two-year period, continues from year to year, provided that such continuation of the Distribution Agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Board, including its Independent Trustees. The Distribution Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its assignment, and is terminable with respect to each Fund at any time without penalty by the Trust (by vote of the Board or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund) or by the Distributor on 60 days’ written notice.

Underwriting Commissions Paid by the Funds

The Distributor and the Previous Distributor received commissions and other compensation for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show amounts paid to the Distributor and the Previous Distributor, as well as amounts the Distributor and Previous Distributor retained, for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 87,653       $ 23,344         —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 10,847       $ 3,032         —     

Class C shares

   $ 813         —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 76,987       $ 42,265       $ 83,846   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 8,679       $ 4,859       $ 10,209   

Class B shares

   $ 6,890       $ 19,621       $ 26,159   

Class C shares

   $ 1,744       $ 1,809       $ 4,085   

Emerging Markets Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 71,380       $ 25,581       $ 15,743   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 11,618       $ 4,445       $ 5,464   

Class C shares

   $ 134       $ 356       $ 117   

 

82


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008*
 

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 367,133       $ 226,149       $ 41,980   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 55,189       $ 37,467       $ 6,898   

Class C shares

   $ 4,646       $ 5,557         —     

Intermediate Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 100,659       $ 75,693       $ 164,058   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 9,832       $ 9,783       $ 17,512   

Class B shares

   $ 20,653       $ 67,508       $ 126,025   

Class C shares

   $ 3,191       $ 13,915       $ 3,509   

Pacific/Asia Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 4,028       $ 1,037         —     

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 576       $ 109         —     

Class C shares

   $ 28         —           —     

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 72,757       $ 35,906       $ 17,771   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 11,067       $ 22,304       $ 2,508   

Class C shares

   $ 1,504       $ 1,487         —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 83,413       $ 599,674       $ 32,972   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 9,858       $ 68,225       $ 4,014   

Class B shares

   $ 20,761       $ 19,230       $ 7,255   

Class C shares

   $ 45,774       $ 36,124       $ 2,579   

Value and Restructuring Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $ 323,994       $ 1,456,148       $ 475,597   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $ 54,926       $ 327,389       $ 81,037   

Class C shares

   $ 22,254       $ 53,825       $ 1,095   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

  
Distributor
     Previous
Distributor
       

High Yield Opportunity Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 2,214       $ 102,312       $ 52,757       $ 81,858   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

     $12,953**       $ 6,397       $ 9,712   

Class B shares

     $12,197**       $ 37,832       $ 120,102   

Class C shares

     $1,882**       $ 2,372       $ 1,294   

 

83


Table of Contents
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008*
 

Fund

  
Distributor
     Previous
Distributor
       

Strategic Income Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 62,252       $ 1,393,488       $ 1,484,623       $ 1,500,658   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

     $212,105**       $ 174,597       $ 182,191   

Class B shares

     $112,534**       $ 254,576       $ 401,532   

Class C shares

     $ 55,451**       $ 38,358       $ 16,683   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009*
 

Fund

   Distributor      Previous
Distributor
    

International Bond Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $  532       $  7,025       $ 5   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     $ 869**       $ 1   

Class C shares

     $     4**         —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008*
 

Fund

  
Distributor
     Previous
Distributor
       

High Yield Municipal Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A Shares

     $14,851         $76,842         $62,416         $79,171   

Amount Retained

           

Class A Shares

     $10,473**        
 
 
 
$7,933
(underwriting
discount)
$33 (CDSC)
  
  
  
  
    
 
 
 
$9,673
(underwriting
discounts)
$12,689 (CDSC)
  
  
  
  

Class B Shares

     $8,610**         $16,011         $23,627   

Class C Shares

     $2,743**         $736         $4,765   

Small Cap Value Fund I

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $26,259         $154,679         $253,305         $350,124   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

     $28,705**        

 
 

 

$40,492

(underwriting
discount)

$519 (CDSC)

  

  
  

  

    
 
 
 
$54,614
(underwriting
discounts)
$1,051 (CDSC)
  
  
  
  

Class B shares

     $36,729**         $69,591         $95,335   

Class C shares

     $5,331**         $7,107         $16,400   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.

 

84


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 20101
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
 
      Distributor      Previous
Distributor
               

Balanced Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $207,936         $337,368         $134,794         $51,909   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

  

 


$81,893**


  


     $19,807        
 
 
$10,387
(underwriting
discount)
  
  
  

Class B shares

  

 

$10,629**

  

     $9,543         $8,501   

Class C shares

  

 

$7,621**

  

     $423         $94   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $19,121         $32,841         $51,601         $180,381   

Class T shares

     $156         $372         $917         $1,016   

Amount Retained

           

Class A Retained

  

 

$7,346**

  

     $7,987         $35,837   

Class B Retained

  

 

$4,870**

  

     $9,579         $12,057   

Class C Retained

  

 

$1,021**

  

     $1,459         $3,558   

Class T Retained

  

 

$61**

  

             $1   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $27,242         $55,837         $101,052         $187,929   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

  

 

$11,901**

  

     $17,113         $30,175   

Class B shares

  

 

$5,690**

  

     $4,599         $1,789   

Class C shares

  

 

$2,854**

  

     $13,038         $1,464   

Strategic Investor Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

     $16,138         $42,407         $76,883         $209,325   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

  

 

$8,700**

  

     $12,250         $241,215   

Class B shares

  

 

$29,424**

  

     $70,039         $83,980   

Class C shares

  

 

$2,257**

  

     $2,303         $4,702   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.
** A portion of the amount shown was retained by the Distributor and the Previous Distributor.
1

Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*
 

Contrarian Core Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     $86,071         $36,936         $19,479   

Class T shares

     $12,088         $28,049         $27,371   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     $12,921        
 
 

 

$6,075
(underwriting
discount)

$11 (CDSC)

  
  
  

  

    
 
 

 

$3,232
(underwriting
discount)

$26 (CDSC)

  
  
  

  

Class B shares

     $4,070         $6,252         $13,877   

Class C shares

     $442         $217         $56   

Class T shares

     $1,659        
 
 
 
$4,121
(underwriting
discount)
— (CDSC)
  
  
 
  
    
 
 
$3,847
(underwriting
discount)
  
  
  

 

85


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009*
   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008*
   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007*

Dividend Income Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $803,682    $286,403    $488,144

Class T shares

   $6,141    $8,615    $11,210

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $125,322    $48,889
(underwriting
discount)

$347 (CDSC)

   $84,117
(underwriting
discount)

$91 (CDSC)

Class B shares

   $39,378    $46,255    $62,830

Class C shares

   $5,857    $3,049    $8,381

Class T shares

   $930    $1,246
(underwriting
discount)
   $1,438
(underwriting
discount)

Large Cap Growth Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $74,526    $98,167    $92,402

Class T shares

   $41,614    $65,452    $55,772

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $18,305    $15,920
(underwriting
discount)

$795 (CDSC)

   $15,320
(underwriting
discount)

$624 (CDSC)

Class B shares

   $33,744    $88,380    $160,928

Class C shares

   $2,549    $3,369    $3,244

Class E shares

   $87    — (underwriting
discount)

$75 (CDSC)

   —  

Class F shares

   N/A    N/A    —  

Class T shares

   $5,524    $8,731
(underwriting
discount)

$4,712 (CDSC)

   $7,274
(underwriting
discount)

Small Cap Core Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

   $65,118    $8,298    $24,792

Class T shares

   $10,735    $17,011    $23,624

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

   $9,774    $1,180
(underwriting
discount)

— (CDSC)

   $3,923
(underwriting
discount)

$3 (CDSC)

Class B shares

   $20,617    $59,022    $70,993

Class C shares

   $100    $339    $507

Class T shares

   $1,442    $2,334
(underwriting
discount)

$451 (CDSC)

   $2,756
(underwriting
discount)

—  

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

86


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007*
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Amount Paid

        

Class A shares

     $81,306         $60,652         $36,337   

Amount Retained

        

Class A shares

     $10,073        
 
 
$7,301
(underwriting
discount)
  
  
  
    
 
 
 
$3,961
(underwriting
discounts)
(CDSC)
  
  
  
  

Class B shares

     $5,835         $13,389         $29,439   

Class C shares

     $168         $467         $40   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007*
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

           

Amount Paid

           

Class A shares

   $ 19,596       $ 27,222       $ 33,423       $ 120,365   

Amount Retained

           

Class A shares

   $ 3,518       $ 5,864       $ 6,160       $ 19,151   

Class B shares

   $ 2,585       $ 6,730       $ 12,250       $ 36,895   

Class C shares

   $ 431       $ 1,207       $ 1,701       $ 1,814   

 

* All amounts were paid to or retained by the Previous Distributor.

LOGO Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest

As described above in the Investment Advisory and Other Services section of this SAI, and in the Management of the Fund – Primary Service Providers section of each Fund’s prospectuses, the Adviser, Administrator, Distributor and Transfer Agent, all affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, receive compensation from the Funds for the various services they provide to the Funds. Additional information as to the specific terms regarding such compensation is set forth in these affiliated service providers’ contracts with the Funds, each of which typically is included as an exhibit to Part C of each Fund’s registration statement.

In many instances, the compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for the services they provide to the Funds is based, in some manner, on the size of the Funds’ assets under management. As the size of the Funds’ assets under management grows, so does the amount of compensation paid to the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates for providing services to the Funds. This relationship between Fund assets and affiliated service provider compensation may create economic and other conflicts of interests of which Fund investors should be aware. These potential conflicts of interest, as well as additional ones, are discussed in detail below and also are addressed in other disclosure materials, including the Funds’ prospectuses. These conflicts of interest also are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials of Ameriprise Financial affiliates that make available or offer the Columbia Funds as investments in connection with their respective products and services. In addition, Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV, which it must file with the SEC as an investment adviser registered under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, provides information about the Adviser’s business, assets under management, affiliates and potential conflicts of interest. Part 1A of the Adviser’s Form ADV is available online through the SEC’s website at www.adviserinfo.sec.gov.

Additional actual or potential conflicts of interest and certain investment activity limitations that could affect the Funds may arise from the financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including, for example, the investment advisory/management services provided for clients and customers other

 

87


Table of Contents

than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial is a major financial services company. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are engaged in a wide range of financial activities beyond the mutual fund-related activities of the Adviser, including, among others, broker/dealer (sales and trading), asset management, insurance and other financial activities. The broad range of financial services activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may involve multiple advisory, transactional, lending, financial and other interests in securities and other instruments, and in companies, that may be bought, sold or held by the Funds. The following describes certain actual and potential conflicts of interest that may be presented.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to the Investment Advisory/Management Activities of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates in Connection With Other Advised/Managed Funds and Accounts

The Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may advise or manage funds and accounts other than the Funds. In this regard, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may provide investment advisory/management and other services to other advised/managed funds and accounts that are similar to those provided to the Funds. The Adviser and Ameriprise Financial’s other investment adviser affiliates (including, for example, Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC) will give advice to and make decisions for all advised/managed funds and accounts, including the Funds, as they believe to be in that fund’s and/or account’s best interests, consistent with their fiduciary duties. The Funds and the other advised/managed funds and accounts of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates are separately and potentially divergently managed, and there is no assurance that any investment advice Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates give to other advised/managed funds and accounts will also be given simultaneously or otherwise to the Funds.

A variety of other actual and potential conflicts of interest may arise from the advisory relationships of the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates with other clients and customers. Advice given to the Funds and/or investment decisions made for the Funds by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may differ from, or may conflict with, advice given to and/or investment decisions made for other advised/managed funds and accounts. As a result, the performance of the Funds may differ from the performance of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. Similarly, a position taken by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, on behalf of other funds or accounts may be contrary to a position taken on behalf of the Funds. Moreover, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may take a position on behalf of other advised/managed funds and accounts, or for their own proprietary accounts, that is adverse to companies or other issuers in which the Funds are invested. For example, the Funds may hold equity securities of a company while another advised/managed fund or account may hold debt securities of the same company. If the portfolio company were to experience financial difficulties, it might be in the best interest of the Funds for the company to reorganize while the interests of the other advised/managed fund or account might be better served by the liquidation of the company. This type of conflict of interest could arise as the result of circumstances that cannot be generally foreseen within the broad range of investment advisory/management activities in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates engage.

Investment transactions made on behalf of other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates also may have a negative effect on the value, price or investment strategies of the Funds. For example, this could occur if another advised/managed fund or account implements an investment decision ahead of, or at the same time as, the Funds and causes the Funds to experience less favorable trading results than they otherwise would have experienced based on market liquidity factors. In addition, the other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, including the other Columbia Funds, may have the same or very similar investment objective and strategies as the Funds. In this situation, the allocation of, and competition for, investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and/or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may create conflicts of interest especially where, for example, limited investment availability is involved. The Adviser has adopted policies and procedures addressing the allocation of investment opportunities among the Funds and other funds and accounts advised by the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

 

88


Table of Contents

 

Sharing of Information among Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may possess information that could be material to the management of a Fund and may not be able to, or may determine not to, share that information with the Fund, even though the information might be beneficial to the Fund. This information may include actual knowledge regarding the particular investments and transactions of other advised/managed funds and accounts, as well as proprietary investment, trading and other market research, analytical and technical models, and new investment techniques, strategies and opportunities. Depending on the context, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will have no obligation to share any such information with the Funds. In general, employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the portfolio managers of the Adviser, will make investment decisions without regard to information otherwise known by other employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and generally will have no obligation to access any such information and may, in some instances, not be able to access such information because of legal and regulatory constraints or the internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For example, if the Adviser or another Ameriprise Financial affiliate, or their respective employees, come into possession of non-public information regarding another advised/managed fund or account, they may be prohibited by legal and regulatory constraints, or internal policies and procedures, from using that information in connection with transactions made on behalf of the Funds. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – The Adviser and Investment Advisory Services – Portfolio Manager(s) – The Adviser’s Portfolio Managers and Potential Conflicts of Interests.

Soft Dollar Benefits

Certain products and services, commonly referred to as “soft dollar services” (including, to the extent permitted by law, research reports, economic and financial data, financial publications, proxy analysis, computer databases and other research-oriented materials), that the Adviser may receive in connection with brokerage services provided to a Fund may have the inadvertent effect of disproportionately benefiting other advised/managed funds or accounts. This could happen because of the relative amount of brokerage services provided to a Fund as compared to other advised/managed funds or accounts, as well as the relative compensation paid by a Fund.

Services Provided to Other Advised/Managed Accounts

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also may act as an investment adviser, investment manager, administrator, transfer agent, custodian, trustee, broker/dealer, agent, or in another capacity, for advised/managed funds and accounts other than the Funds, and may receive compensation for acting in such capacity. This compensation that the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates receive could be greater than the compensation Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates receive for acting in the same or similar capacity for the Funds. In addition, the Adviser, Distributor and Transfer Agent and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may receive other benefits, including enhancement of new or existing business relationships. This compensation and/or the benefits that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may receive from other advised/managed funds and accounts and other relationships could potentially create incentives to favor other advised/managed funds and accounts over the Funds. Trades made by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates for the Funds may be, but are not required to be, aggregated with trades made for other funds and accounts advised/managed by the Adviser and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates. If trades are aggregated among the Funds and those other funds and accounts, the various prices of the securities being traded may be averaged, which could have the potential effect of disadvantaging the Funds as compared to the other funds and accounts with which trades were aggregated.

Proxy Voting

Although the Adviser endeavors to make all proxy voting decisions with respect to the interests of the Funds for which it is responsible in accordance with its proxy voting policies and procedures, the Adviser’s proxy voting decisions with respect to a Fund’s portfolio securities may nonetheless benefit other advised/managed

 

89


Table of Contents

funds and accounts, and/or clients, of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. The Adviser has adopted proxy voting policies and procedures that are designed to provide that all proxy voting is done in the best interests of its clients, including the Funds, without any resulting benefit or detriment to the Adviser and/or its affiliates, including Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. For more information about the Adviser’s proxy voting policies and procedures, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures.

Certain Trading Activities

The directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may buy and sell securities or other investments for their own accounts, and in doing so may take a position that is adverse to the Funds. In order to reduce the possibility that such personal investment activities of the directors/trustees, officers and employees of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates will materially adversely affect the Funds, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have adopted policies and procedures, and the Funds, the Board, the Adviser and the Distributor have each adopted a Code of Ethics that addresses such personal investment activities. For more information, see Investment Advisory and Other Services – Codes of Ethics.

Affiliate Transactions

Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may enter into transactions in which Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates, or companies that are deemed to be affiliates of a Fund because of, among other factors, their or their affiliates’ ownership or control of shares of the Fund, may have an interest that potentially conflicts with the interests of the Fund. For example, an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial may sell securities to a Fund from an offering in which it is an underwriter or that it owns as a dealer, subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements. Applicable legal and regulatory requirements also may prevent a Fund from engaging in transactions with an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, or from participating in an investment opportunity in which an affiliate of a Fund participates.

Certain Investment Limitations

Regulatory and other restrictions may limit a Fund’s investment activities in various ways. For example, regulations regarding certain industries and markets, such as emerging or international markets, and certain transactions, such as those involving certain futures and derivatives as well as restrictions applicable to certain issuers (e.g., poison pills), may impose limits on the aggregate amount of investments that may be made by affiliated investors, including accounts owned or managed by the same or affiliated managers, in the aggregate or in individual issuers. In these circumstances, the Adviser may be prevented from acquiring securities for a Fund that it might otherwise prefer to acquire if the acquisition would cause the Fund and its affiliated investors to exceed an applicable limit. These types of regulatory and other applicable limits are complex and vary significantly in different contexts including, among others, from country to country, industry to industry and issuer to issuer. The Adviser has procedures in place designed to monitor potential conflicts arising from regulatory and other limits. Nonetheless, given the complexity of these limits, the Adviser and its affiliates may inadvertently breach these limits, and a Fund may therefore be required to sell securities that it might otherwise prefer to hold in order to comply with such limits. At certain times, a Fund may be restricted in its investment activities because of relationships that an affiliate of the Fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, may have with the issuers of securities. This could happen, for example, if a Fund desired to buy a security issued by a company for which Ameriprise Financial or an affiliate serves as underwriter. The internal policies and procedures of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates covering these types of restrictions and addressing similar issues also may at times restrict a Fund’s investment activities. See also About the Funds’ Investments – Certain Investment Activity Limits.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates’ Non-Advisory Relationships with Clients and Customers other than the Funds

The financial relationships that Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may have with companies and other entities in which a Fund may invest can give rise to actual and potential conflicts of interest. Subject to applicable

 

90


Table of Contents

legal and regulatory requirements, a Fund may invest (a) in the securities of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or in companies in which Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have an equity, debt or other interest, and/or (b) in the securities of companies held by other Columbia Funds. The purchase, holding and sale of such securities by a Fund may enhance the profitability and the business interests of Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates and/or other Columbia Funds. There also may be limitations as to the sharing with the Adviser of information derived from the non-investment advisory/management activities of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates because of legal and regulatory constraints and internal policies and procedures (such as information barriers and ethical walls). Because of these limitations, Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates generally will not share information derived from its non-investment advisory/management activities with the Adviser.

Actual and Potential Conflicts of Interest Related to Ameriprise Financial Affiliates’ Marketing and Use of the Columbia Funds as Investment Options

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates also provide a variety of products and services that, in some manner, may utilize the Columbia Funds as investment options. For example, the Columbia Funds may be offered as investments in connection with brokerage and other securities products offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, and may be utilized as investments in connection with fiduciary, investment management and other accounts offered by affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, as well as for other Columbia Funds structured as “funds of funds.” The use of the Columbia Funds in connection with other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates may introduce economic and other conflicts of interest. These conflicts of interest are highlighted in account documentation and other disclosure materials for the other products and services offered by Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates.

Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, including the Adviser, may make payments to their affiliates in connection with the promotion and sale of the Funds’ shares, in addition to the sales-related and other compensation that these parties may receive from the Funds. As a general matter, personnel of Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, do not receive compensation in connection with their sales or use of the Funds that is greater than that paid in connection with their sales of other comparable products and services. Nonetheless, because the compensation that the Adviser and other affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may receive for providing services to the Funds is generally based on the Funds’ assets under management and those assets will grow as shares of the Funds are sold, potential conflicts of interest may exist. See Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Financial Intermediary Payments for more information.

Other Services Provided

The Transfer Agent

Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (formerly, RiverSource Service Corporation) is the transfer agent for the Funds. The Transfer Agent is located at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111. Under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Transfer Agent provides transfer agency, dividend disbursing agency and shareholder servicing agency services to the Funds. Effective September 7, 2010, the Funds pay the Transfer Agent an annual transfer agency fee of $12.08 per account, payable monthly for all share classes, except for Class I shares, and, prior to September 7, 2010, paid the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) an annual transfer agency fee of $22.36 per account, payable monthly.

In addition, effective September 7, 2010, the Funds reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds in an annual amount equal to 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the Fund’s shares maintained in such omnibus accounts (other than omnibus accounts for which American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc. is the broker of record or accounts where the beneficial owner is a customer of Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., for which the Transfer Agent is reimbursed $16.00 annually, calculated monthly based on the total number of positions in such accounts at the end of such month) for all share classes, except for Class I, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares. For Class R4 and Class R5 shares, the Funds reimburse the Transfer Agent for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the Funds subject to an annual

 

91


Table of Contents

limitation of 0.05% of the net assets attributable to such shares. Prior to September 7, 2010, the Funds reimbursed the Transfer Agent (and, prior to May 1, 2010, the Previous Transfer Agent) for the fees and expenses the Transfer Agent paid to financial intermediaries that maintained omnibus accounts with the Funds, subject to a cap of up to $22.36 per account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent on a per account basis and a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by such an account for financial intermediaries that sought payment by the Transfer Agent based on a percentage of net assets.

The Funds also pay certain reimbursable out-of-pocket expenses of the Transfer Agent. The Transfer Agent also may retain as additional compensation for its services revenues for fees for wire, telephone and redemption orders, IRA trustee agent fees and account transcripts due the Transfer Agent from Fund shareholders and credits (net of bank charges) earned with respect to balances in accounts the Transfer Agent maintains in connection with its services to the Funds.

For the period November 1, 2007 through October 31, 2009, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual transfer agency fee of $17.34 per account, payable monthly. In addition, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid for the fees and expenses the Previous Transfer Agent paid to third party dealer firms that maintained omnibus accounts with certain of the Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.15% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account. For the period April 1, 2006 through October 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was paid an annual fee of $17.00 per account, payable monthly. For the period September 1, 2005 through October 31, 2007, the Previous Transfer Agent was entitled to reimbursement by certain Funds for the fees and expenses that the Previous Transfer Agent paid to dealer firms or transfer agents that maintained omnibus accounts with such Funds, subject to a cap equal to 0.11% of a Fund’s net assets represented by the account.

The Funds that offer Class R4 shares have a Plan Administration Services Agreement with the Transfer Agent. Under the agreement, the Funds pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and Health Savings Accounts (HSAs). The fee for services is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of the average daily net assets of each Fund attributable to Class R4 shares.

Transfer agency costs for each Fund are calculated separately for each of (i) Class Y shares, (ii) Class R4 and Class R5 shares and (iii) all other share classes (except Class I shares, which pay no transfer agency fees). Pursuant to the Administrative Services Agreement, the Administrator pays the Transfer Agency Fees of U.S. Treasury Index Fund on behalf of the Fund. The fees paid to the Transfer Agent may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval.

The Transfer Agent retains BFDS/DST, 2 Heritage Drive, North Quincy, MA 02171 as the Funds’ sub-transfer agent. BFDS/DST assists the Transfer Agent in carrying out its duties.

The Custodian

State Street, which is located at State Street Financial Center, One Lincoln Street, Boston, MA 02111, is the Funds’ Custodian. State Street is responsible for safeguarding the Funds’ cash and securities, receiving and delivering securities and collecting the Funds’ interest and dividends.

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, which is located at 125 High Street, Boston, MA 02110, is the Funds’ independent registered public accounting firm. The Funds issue unaudited financial statements semi-annually and audited financial statements annually. The financial statements for the fiscal years ended on or after August 31, 2009 contained in a Fund’s Annual Report were audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. The Board has selected PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as the independent registered public accounting firm to audit the Funds’ books and review their tax returns for the fiscal years ended on or after August 31, 2010.

 

92


Table of Contents

 

The Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and the audited financial statements are included in the annual reports to shareholders of the Funds, and are incorporated herein by reference. No other parts of the annual reports or semi-annual reports to shareholders are incorporated by reference herein. The financial statements incorporated by reference into the Funds’ prospectuses and this SAI have been so incorporated in reliance upon the report of the independent registered public accounting firm, given on its authority as an expert in auditing and accounting.

Counsel

Ropes & Gray LLP serves as legal counsel to the Trust. Its address is One International Place, Boston, Massachusetts 02110. K&L Gates LLP serves as co-counsel. Its address is 1601 K Street N.W., Washington, DC, 20006-1600.

Distribution and Servicing Plans

The Trust has adopted distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans for the Class A shares, Class B shares, Class C shares, Class E shares, Class F shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares, Class T shares and Class W shares of the Funds. See Capital Stock and Other Securities for information about which Funds offer which classes of shares. The Funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, Class E shares, Class F shares or Class T shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in any such shares. See the prospectuses for these share classes of the Funds for details.

The table below shows the maximum annual distribution and/or services fees (payable monthly and calculated based on an annual percentage of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees applicable to each share class:

 

      Distribution
Fee
   Service
Fee
   Combined
Total

Class A

   up to 0.10%    0.25%    up to  0.35%a,b

Class B

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%b

Class C

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%b,c

Class E

   0.10%    0.25%    0.35%

Class F

   0.75%    0.25%    1.00%

Class I

   none    none    none

Class R

   0.50%    —  d    0.50%

Class R4

   none    0.25%e    0.25%e

Class R5

   none    none    none

Class T

   none    0.50%f    0.50%f

Class W

   0.25%    0.25%    0.25%

Class Y

   none    none    none

Class Z

   none    none    none

 

a

As shown in the table below, the maximum distribution and service fees of Class A shares varies among the Funds.

 

Columbia funds

   Class A
Distribution
Fee
    Class A
Service
Fee
    Class A
Combined
Total
 

Balanced Fund, Contrarian Core Fund, Dividend Income Fund, Intermediate Bond Fund, Large Cap Growth Fund, Mid Cap Growth Fund, Real Estate Equity Fund, Small Cap Core Fund, Small Cap Growth Fund I

     0.10     0.25     0.35 %* 

Bond Fund, Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund, Corporate Income Fund, Emerging Markets Fund, Energy and Natural Resources Fund, High Yield Opportunity Fund, International Bond Fund, Pacific/Asia Fund, Select Large Cap Growth Fund, Small Cap Value Fund I, Strategic Income Fund, Strategic Investor Fund, U.S. Treasury Index Fund, Value and Restructuring Fund

     —          0.25     0.25

High Yield Municipal Fund

     —          0.20     0.20

 

* The indicated Funds may pay distribution and service fees up to a maximum of 0.35% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class A shares (comprised of up to 0.10% for distribution services and up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services) but currently limit such fees to an aggregate fee of not more than 0.25% for Class A shares.

 

93


Table of Contents
b

Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.10% on net assets attributable to shares of the Fund issued prior to December 1, 1994, and 0.25% on net assets attributable to Fund shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.10% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2009, the blended service fee was 0.24% of the Fund’s average net assets. Service Fee for Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares of Strategic Income Fund – The annual service fee may equal up to 0.15% on net assets attributable to shares of this Fund issued prior to January 1, 1993 and 0.25% on net assets attributable to shares issued thereafter. This arrangement results in a rate of service fee for all Fund shares that is a blend between the 0.15% and 0.25% rates. For the fiscal year ended May 31, 2010, the blended service fee was 0.25% of the Fund’s average net assets.

c

The Distributor has voluntarily agreed to waive a portion of the distribution fee for Class C shares of the following Funds so that the combined distribution and service fee (or the distribution fee for Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund) does not exceed the specified percentage annually: 0.45% for Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund; 0.80% for High Yield Municipal Fund; 0.85% for Corporate Income Fund, Intermediate Bond Fund, Strategic Income Fund and U.S. Treasury Index Fund. These arrangements may be modified or terminated by the Distributor at any time.

d

Class R shares pay a distribution fee pursuant to a Fund’s distribution (Rule 12b-1) plan for Class R shares. The Funds do not have a shareholder service plan for Class R shares.

e

The shareholder service fees for Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a Plan Administration Services Agreement, the Funds’ Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

f

The shareholder servicing fees for Class T shares are up to 0.50% of average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for equity Funds and 0.40% for fixed income Funds. The Funds currently limit such fees to a maximum of 0.30% for equity Funds and 0.15% for fixed income Funds. See Class T Shares Shareholder Service Fees below for more information.

The shareholder servicing plan permits the Funds to compensate or reimburse servicing agents for the shareholder services they have provided. The Distribution Plan, adopted pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, permits the Funds to compensate or reimburse the Distributor and/or selling agents for activities or expenses primarily intended to result in the sale of the classes’ shares. Payments are made at an annual rate and paid monthly, as a percentage of average daily net assets, set from time to time by the Board, and are charged as expenses of each Fund directly to the applicable share class. A substantial portion of the expenses incurred pursuant to these plans may be paid to affiliates of the Distributor and Ameriprise Financial.

Under the shareholder servicing plan, the Board must review, at least quarterly, a written report of the amounts paid under the servicing agreements and the purposes for which those expenditures were made. The initial term of the shareholder servicing plan is one year and it will continue in effect from year to year after its initial one-year term provided that its continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a majority of the Board, including a majority of the Independent Trustees who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the shareholder servicing plan or in any agreement related to it. Any material amendment to the shareholder servicing plan must be approved in the same manner. The shareholder servicing plan is terminable at any time with respect to the Funds by a vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees.

The Trustees believe the Distribution Plan could be a significant factor in the growth and retention of a Fund’s assets resulting in more advantageous expense ratios and increased investment flexibility which could benefit each class of Fund shareholders. The Distribution Plan will continue in effect from year to year so long as continuance is specifically approved at least annually by a vote of the Trustees, including the Independent Trustees. The Distribution Plan may not be amended to increase the fee materially without approval by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares, and all material amendments of the Distribution Plan must be approved by the Trustees in the manner provided in the foregoing sentence. The Distribution Plan may be terminated at any time by vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the relevant class of shares.

Class T Shares Shareholder Service Fees

The Funds that offer Class T shares have adopted a shareholder servicing plan that permits them to pay for certain services provided to Class T shareholders by their selling and/or servicing agents. Equity Funds may pay

 

94


Table of Contents

shareholder service fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.50% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of up to 0.25% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.25% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.30% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services. Fixed income Funds may pay shareholder service fees up to an aggregate annual rate of 0.40% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares (comprised of an annual rate of up to 0.20% for shareholder liaison services and up to 0.20% for administrative support services), but such fees will not exceed the Fund’s net investment income attributable to Class T shares. These fees are currently limited to an aggregate annual rate of not more than 0.15% of the Fund’s average daily net assets attributable to Class T shares for shareholder liaison services and administrative support services. The Funds consider “administrative support services” to include, without limitation, (i) aggregating and processing purchase and redemption orders, (ii) providing beneficial owners with statements showing their positions in the Fund, (iii) processing dividend payments, (iv) providing sub-accounting services for Fund shares held beneficially, (v) forwarding shareholder communications, such as proxies, shareholder reports, dividend and tax notices, and updating prospectuses to beneficial owners, (vi) receiving, tabulating and transmitting proxies executed by the beneficial owners, (vii) sub-transfer agent services for beneficial owners of the Fund shares and (viii) other similar services.

Distribution and Service Fees Paid by the Funds

The Distributor and the Previous Distributor received distribution and service fees from the Funds for their services as reflected in the following charts, which show distribution and service fees paid to and waived by, as applicable, the Distributor and the Previous Distributor, for the most recently completed fiscal year, except as otherwise indicated. The Trust is not aware as to what amount, if any, of the distribution and service fees paid to the Distributor and Previous Distributor were, on a Fund-by-Fund basis, used for advertising, printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than current shareholders, compensation to broker-dealers, compensation to sales personnel, or interest, carrying or other financing charges. Class Y shares and Class Z shares do not pay distribution and service fees.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2010*

 

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Bond Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           —         $ 13,110         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 29,341         —         $ 4,370         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A   

Corporate Income Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 56,609       $ 84,028         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 204,427       $ 18,855       $ 28,014         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —         $ 16,837         N/A   

Emerging Markets Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 7,090         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 10,730         N/A       $ 2,363         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           N/A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 89,532         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 95,419         N/A       $ 29,844         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           N/A   

Intermediate Bond Fund

           

Distribution Fee

   $ 159,958       $ 266,146       $ 239,468       $ 8,902   

Service Fee

   $ 399,760       $ 88,709       $ 79,839         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

   $ 159,958         —         $ 47,893         N/A   

 

95


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares      Class R Shares  

Pacific/Asia Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 2,781         N/A   

Service Fee

   $ 1,579         N/A       $ 927         N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           N/A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 14,917       $ 618   

Service Fee

   $ 769,303         N/A       $ 4,972         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           —     

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 56,393       $ 184,245         —     

Service Fee

   $ 148,960       $ 18,798       $ 61,427         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —         $ 36,843         —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

           

Distribution Fee

     —           N/A       $ 473,717       $ 258,974   

Service Fee

   $ 610,589         N/A       $ 157,906         —     

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           N/A         —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid or waived by the Previous Distributor.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended May 31, 2010

 

    Class A Shares     Class B Shares     Class C Shares     Class J Shares*  

Fund

  Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

               

Distribution Fee

    —          —        $ 10,429      $ 147,519      $ 8,223      $ 89,599        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

  $ 41,009      $ 429,929      $ 3,469      $ 49,173      $ 2,714      $ 29,852        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

    —          —          —          —        $ 1,645      $ 17,946        N/A        N/A   

International Bond Fund

               

Distribution Fee

    —          —          N/A        N/A      $ 64      $ 317        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

  $ 213      $ 1,522        N/A        N/A      $ 195      $ 949        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

    —          —          N/A        N/A        —          —          N/A        N/A   

Strategic Income Fund

               

Distribution Fee

    —          —        $ 59,732      $ 774,956      $ 126,549      $ 1,320,458        —        $ 28,560   

Service Fee

  $ 216,952      $ 2,300,745      $ 19,540      $ 255,683      $ 42,458      $ 435,805        —        $ 20,076   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

    —          —          —          —        $ 25,310      $ 262,023        —          —     

 

* On July 27, 2009, Strategic Income Fund liquidated and terminated Class J shares.

 

96


Table of Contents

 

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended June 30, 2010

 

     Class A Shares      Class B Shares      Class C Shares  

Fund

   Distributor      Previous
Distributor
     Distributor      Previous
Distributor
     Distributor      Previous
Distributor
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

                 

Distribution Fee

     —           —           $7,716         $46,609         $9,271         $44,660   

Service Fee

     $27,169         $112,152         $2,058         $12,428         $3,090         $14,887   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

                 

Distribution Fee

     —           —           $32,481         $188,879         $68,350         $327,919   

Service Fee

     $266,253         $1,175,984         $10,827         $  62,959         $22,783         $109,306   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended August 31, 2010*1

 

     Class A Shares     Class B Shares     Class C Shares     Class R Shares     Class T Shares**  

Fund

  Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
    Distributor     Previous
Distributor
 

Balanced Fund

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $17,743        $36,746        $60,965        $80,541        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

    $48,934        $48,551        $ 5,914        $12,249        $20,477        $26,809        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

                                              N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $15,838        $40,577        $26,090        $50,883        $8,167        $13,987                 

Service Fee

    $55,624        $101,648        $ 5,279        $13,526        $ 8,697        $16,961                               

Fees Waived by the Distributor

        

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

Small Cap Growth Fund I

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $6,386        $14,230        $35,553        $61,671        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

    $54,406        $102,137        $2,129        $ 4,743        $11,851        $20,557        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

        

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

Strategic Investor Fund

                   

Distribution Fee

                  $55,413        $127,463        $43,771        $99,781        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Service Fee

    $127,413        $277,644        $18,471        $ 42,488        $14,590        $33,260        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

        

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

 

N/A

  

 

*

All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

** Paid pursuant to the Shareholder Services Plan for Class T shares.
1

Unaudited.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Funds for the Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2009*

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
     Class E
Shares
     Class F
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class T
Shares**
 

Contrarian Core Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 20,833       $ 23,402         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

   $ 35,066       $ 6,953       $ 7,797         N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 299,111   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Dividend Income Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 192,252       $ 194,696         N/A         N/A       $ 689         —     

Service Fee

   $ 810,948       $ 64,084       $ 64,929         N/A         N/A         —         $ 179,754   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A         —           —     

 

97


Table of Contents

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
     Class E
Shares
     Class F
Shares
     Class R
Shares
     Class T
Shares**
 

Large Cap Growth Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 227,129       $ 118,242       $ 11,426       $ 1,852         N/A         —     

Service Fee

   $ 308,522       $ 75,710       $ 39,444       $ 28,565       $ 617         N/A       $ 380,511   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           —           —           N/A         —     

Small Cap Core Fund

                    

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 113,507       $ 116,645         N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

Service Fee

   $ 183,736       $ 37,882       $ 38,938         N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 191,678   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —           N/A         N/A         N/A         —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.
** Paid pursuant to the Shareholder Services Plan for Class T shares.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Fund for the Fiscal Year Ended October 31, 2009*

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

        

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 68,025       $ 89,850   

Service Fee

   $ 171,733       $ 21,786       $ 28,797   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —         $ 35,944   

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Fund for the Fiscal Year Ended August 31, 2009*

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

        

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 26,912       $ 26,164   

Service Fee

   $ 35,816       $ 8,971       $ 8,721   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —     

 

* All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

Distribution and Services Fees Paid by the Fund for the Fiscal Period Ended December 31, 2009*, 1

 

Fund

   Class A
Shares
     Class B
Shares
     Class C
Shares
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

        

Distribution Fee

     —         $ 8,375       $ 9,509   

Service Fee

   $ 14,539       $ 2,791       $ 3,170   

Fees Waived by the Distributor

     —           —           —     

 

*

All amounts were paid to or waived by the Previous Distributor.

1

Data for the fiscal period September 1, 2009 through December 31, 2009.

The Distributor may use the entire amount of its fees to defray the costs of commissions and service fees paid to selling and/or servicing agents and for certain other purposes. Since the distribution and service fees are payable regardless of the Distributor’s expenses, the Distributor may realize a profit from the fees. The Distribution Plan authorizes any other payments by the Funds to the Distributor and its affiliates (including the Adviser) to the extent that such payments might be construed to be indirectly financing the distribution of a Fund’s shares.

 

98


Table of Contents

 

The Funds participate in joint distribution activities with other Columbia Funds. The fees paid under the Distribution Plan adopted by a Fund may be used to finance the distribution of the shares of other Columbia Funds. Such distribution costs are allocated based on the relative net asset size of the respective Funds.

 

99


Table of Contents

 

Codes of Ethics

The Funds, the Adviser and the Distributor have adopted Codes of Ethics pursuant to the requirements of the 1940 Act, including Rule 17j–1 under the 1940 Act. These Codes of Ethics permit personnel subject to the Codes of Ethics to invest in securities, including securities that may be bought or held by the Funds. These Codes of Ethics are included as exhibits to Part C of the Funds’ registration statement. These Codes of Ethics can be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room and may be obtained by calling the SEC at 202.551.8090; they also are available on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov, and may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request to publicinfo@sec.gov or by writing to the SEC’s Public Reference Section, Washington, D.C. 20549–1520.

Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures

The Funds have delegated to the Adviser, or as applicable, the subadviser, the responsibility to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Funds. In deciding to delegate this responsibility to the Adviser, the Board reviewed and approved the policies and procedures adopted by the Adviser and, as applicable, a subadviser. These included the procedures that the Adviser follows when a vote presents a conflict between the interests of the Funds and their shareholders and the Adviser (or subadviser), its affiliates, its other clients or other persons.

The Adviser’s policy is to vote all proxies for Fund securities in a manner considered by the Adviser to be in the best interest of the Funds and their shareholders without regard to any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser examines each proposal and votes against the proposal, if, in its judgment, approval or adoption of the proposal would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities. The Adviser also examines each proposal and votes the proxies against the proposal, if, in its judgment, the proposal would be expected to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. The Adviser determines the best interest of the Funds in light of the potential economic return on each Fund’s investment.

The Adviser seeks to address potential material conflicts of interest by having predetermined voting guidelines. For those proposals that require special consideration or in instances where special circumstances may require varying from the predetermined guideline, the Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee determines the vote in the best interest of the Funds, without consideration of any benefit to the Adviser, its affiliates, its other clients or other persons. The Adviser’s Proxy Voting Committee is composed of representatives of the Adviser’s equity investments, equity research, compliance, legal and operations functions. In addition to the responsibilities described above, the Proxy Voting Committee has the responsibility to review, at least annually, the Adviser’s proxy voting policies to ensure consistency with internal policies and regulatory requirements and to develop additional predetermined voting guidelines to assist in the review of proxy proposals.

The Proxy Voting Committee may vary from a predetermined guideline if it determines that voting on the proposal according to the predetermined guideline would be expected to have an adverse impact on the current or potential market value of the issuer’s securities or to affect adversely the best interest of the Funds. References to the best interests of the Funds refer to the interest of the Funds in terms of the potential economic return on the client’s investment. In determining the vote on any proposal, the Proxy Voting Committee does not consider any benefit other than benefits to the Funds. A member of the Proxy Voting Committee is prohibited from voting on any proposal for which he or she has a conflict of interest by reason of a direct relationship with the issuer or other party affected by a given proposal. Persons making recommendations to the Proxy Voting Committee or its members are required to disclose to the Committee any relationship with a party making a proposal or other matter known to the person that would create a potential conflict of interest.

The Adviser has retained Glass-Lewis & Co., a third-party vendor, to implement its proxy voting process. Glass-Lewis & Co. provides proxy analysis, record keeping services and vote disclosure services.

Information regarding how the Columbia Funds (except certain Columbia Funds that do not invest in voting securities) voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent twelve month period ended June 30 will be available by August 31 of this year free of charge: (i) through the Columbia Funds’ website at www.columbiamanagement.com and (ii) on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. For a copy of the Adviser’s (and subadviser’s) policies and procedures that are used to determine how to vote proxies relating to portfolio securities held by the Columbia Funds, see Appendix B to this SAI.

 

100


Table of Contents

 

FUND GOVERNANCE

The Board

Leadership Structure and Risk Oversight

The Board oversees the Trust and the Funds. The Trustees are responsible for overseeing the management and operations of the Trust. The Board consists of ten Trustees who have varied experience and skills. Nine of the Trustees, including the Chairman of the Board, are Independent Trustees. The remaining Trustee, Mr. William E. Mayer, may technically be an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Columbia Funds by reason of his affiliation with WR Hambrecht + Co., a registered broker/dealer that may execute portfolio transactions for, engage in principal transactions with, or distribute shares of a Fund or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or any subadviser to a Fund. Further information about the backgrounds and qualifications of the Trustees can be found in the section Trustee Biographical Information and Qualifications. The Board has several standing committees, which are an integral part of each Fund’s overall governance and risk oversight structure. The committees include the Audit Committee, the Governance Committee, the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee, the Compliance Committee and the Investment Oversight Committees. A majority of the members of each of the committees are Independent Trustees. The roles of each committee are more fully described in the section Standing Committees below.

The Funds have retained the Adviser as the Funds’ investment adviser and administrator. The Adviser provides the Funds with investment advisory services, and is responsible for day-to-day administration of the Funds and management of the risks that arise from the Funds’ investments and operations. The Board provides oversight of the services provided by the Adviser, including risk management services. In addition, each committee of the Board provides oversight of the Adviser’s risk management services with respect to the particular activities within the committee’s purview. In the course of providing oversight, the Board and the committees receive a wide range of reports with respect to the Funds’ activities, including reports regarding each Fund’s investment portfolio, the compliance of the Funds with applicable laws, and the Funds’ financial accounting and reporting. The Board and the relevant committees meet periodically with officers of the Funds and the Adviser, with independent consultants hired by the Board, and with representatives of various of the Funds’ service providers. The Board and certain committees also meet periodically with the Funds’ chief compliance officer, who also serves as chief compliance officer of the Adviser, to receive reports regarding the compliance of the Funds and the Adviser with the federal securities laws and their internal compliance policies and procedures. In addition, the Board meets periodically with the portfolio managers of the Funds to receive reports regarding the management of the Funds, including their investment risks.

The Board reviews its leadership structure periodically and believes that its structure is appropriate, in light of the size of the Trust and the nature of its business, to enable the Board to exercise its oversight of the Funds and the other investment companies overseen by the Trustees. In particular, the Board believes that having an Independent Trustee serve as the chair of the Board and having other Independent Trustees serve as chairs of each committee promotes independence from the Adviser in setting agendas and conducting meetings. The Board believes that its committee structure makes the oversight process more efficient and more effective by allowing, among other things, smaller groups of Trustees to bring increased focus to matters within the purview of each committee.

Standing Committees

Ms. Verville and Messrs. Collins, Hacker and Nelson are members of the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee’s functions include making recommendations to the Board regarding the selection and performance of the independent registered public accounting firm, and reviewing matters relating to accounting and auditing practices and procedures, accounting records and the internal accounting controls of the Funds and certain service providers.

 

101


Table of Contents

 

Messrs. Drake, Hacker, Mayer and Simpson are members of the Governance Committee. The Governance Committee’s functions include recommending to the Board nominees for Independent Trustee positions and for appointments to various committees, overseeing the Board’s periodic evaluations of the effectiveness of the Board, reviewing and recommending to the Board governance and other policies and practices to be followed in carrying out the Trustees’ duties and responsibilities and reviewing and making recommendations to the Board regarding the compensation of the Trustees who are not affiliated with the Adviser.

The Governance Committee will consider nominees for Trustee recommended by shareholders provided that such recommendations are submitted by the date disclosed in a Fund’s proxy statement and otherwise comply with applicable securities laws, including Rule 14a-8 under the 1934 Act. Such shareholder recommendations must be in writing and should be sent to the attention of the Governance Committee in care of the Fund at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111-2621. Shareholder recommendations should include the proposed nominee’s biographical information (including business experience for the past ten years) and a description of the qualifications of the proposed nominee, along with a statement from the proposed nominee that he or she is willing to serve and meets the requirements to be a disinterested Trustee, if applicable.

Ms. Kelly and Messrs. Hacker, Mayer, Nelson, Neuhauser and Piel are members of the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee. The Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee’s functions include reviewing and making recommendations to the Board as to contracts requiring approval of a majority of the Independent Trustees and as to any other contracts that may be referred to the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee by the Board.

Mses. Kelly and Verville and Messrs. Nelson and Simpson are members of the Compliance Committee. The Compliance Committee’s functions include, among other things, monitoring, supervising and assessing the performance of each Fund’s Chief Compliance Officer and reviewing her compensation, reviewing periodically and recommending changes to the codes of ethics and compliance policies of each Fund and its service providers, and reviewing each Fund’s portfolio execution.

Each Trustee also serves on an Investment Oversight Committee (IOC). Each IOC is responsible for monitoring, on an ongoing basis, a select group of funds in the Columbia Funds Family and gives particular consideration to such matters as each Fund’s adherence to its investment mandates, historical performance, changes in investment processes and personnel, and proposed changes to investment objectives. Investment personnel who manage the Funds attend IOC meetings from time to time to assist each IOC in its review of the Funds. Each IOC meets four times a year, as the applicable IOC did for each Fund’s most recently completed fiscal year. The below are members of the respective IOCs and the general categories of funds in the Columbia Funds Family which they review. These asset categories may be reassigned among the IOCs from time to time.

IOC #1: Mr. Neuhauser and Ms. Verville are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Global Stock, International Stock, Large Growth, Mid Value; Fixed Income – Core and Municipal.

IOC #2: Messrs. Collins, Hacker and Mayer are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Large Value, Small Growth, Specialty; Fixed Income – High Yield, Multi-Sector and Municipal.

IOC #3: Mr. Piel and Ms. Kelly are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Asset Allocation, Index, Large Value, Mid Value, Small Core, Small Value, Money Market; Fixed Income – Municipal and Short Duration.

IOC #4: Messrs. Drake, Nelson and Simpson are responsible for reviewing funds in the following asset categories: Asset Allocation, Large Blend, Mid Growth, Multi Blend, Small Growth, Specialty; Fixed Income – Core, Municipal and Short Duration.

 

102


Table of Contents

 

The table below shows the number of times each committee met during each Fund’s most recent fiscal year. The table is organized by fiscal year end.

 

Fiscal Period

   Audit
Committee
    Governance
Committee
    Advisory Fees &
Expenses
Committee
    Compliance
Committee
    Investment
Oversight

Committee
 

For Funds with fiscal periods ending March 31

     8        6        8        8        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending May 31

     8        7        8        9        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending June 30

     8        7        8        8        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending August 31

     8        7        9        7        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending September 30

     6        6        8        7        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending October 31

     6        6        8        7        4   

For Funds with fiscal periods ending December 31

     3 a      2 a      4 a      4 a      1 a 

 

a

In 2009, Real Estate Equity Fund changed its fiscal year end from August 31 to December 31. The number of committee meetings in the table above reflects the period from September 1, 2009 through December 31, 2009. For the fiscal year ended August 31, 2009, the Audit Committee met six times, the Governance Committee met six times, the Advisory Fees & Expenses Committee met eight times, the Compliance Committee met six times and each IOC met four times.

Trustee Biographical Information and Qualifications

The following provides an overview of the considerations that led the Board to conclude that each individual serving as a Trustee should so serve. Generally, no one factor was decisive in the selection of an individual to join the Board. Among the factors the Board considered when concluding that an individual should serve on the Board were the following: (i) the individual’s business and professional experience and accomplishments; (ii) the individual’s ability to work effectively with the other Trustees; (iii) the individual’s prior experience, if any, serving on the boards of public companies (including, where relevant, other investment companies) and other complex enterprises and organizations; and (iv) how the individual’s skills, experience and attributes would contribute to an appropriate mix of relevant skills and experience on the Board.

In respect of each current Trustee, the individual’s substantial professional accomplishments and experience, including in fields related to the operations of the Fund, were a significant factor in the determination that, in light of the business and structure of the Trust, the individual should serve as a Trustee. Following is a summary of each Trustee’s particular professional experience and additional considerations that contributed to the Board’s conclusion that an individual should serve as a Trustee:

Rodman L. Drake – Mr. Drake has significant experience serving as a CEO on boards of directors for public companies, including investment companies. This experience includes holding such positions with the various boards as chairman, lead independent director, and chairman of the nominating, compensation and audit committees. Mr. Drake is Co-Founder of Baringo Capital LLC, and was previously the CEO of a hybrid REIT, president of a private equity firm and the CEO of a leading management consulting firm.

John D. Collins – Mr. Collins was a partner at KPMG, LLP, where he worked for 37 years until his retirement in 1999. Mr. Collins has served on the board of directors for multiple companies. While with KPMG LLP, Mr. Collins was a senior audit partner. He also served on the International Auditing Procedures Committee.

 

103


Table of Contents

 

Douglas A. Hacker – Mr. Hacker has extensive executive experience, having served in various executive roles with United Airlines and more recently as an independent business executive. Mr. Hacker also has experience on other boards of directors. As former chief financial officer of United Airlines, Mr. Hacker has significant experience in accounting and financial management, including in a public company setting.

Janet Langford Kelly – Ms. Kelly is Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary for ConocoPhillips. Prior to joining ConocoPhillips Ms. Kelly held senior legal and leadership roles in other large corporations and law firms, including as a partner at the law firms Sidley & Austin and at Zelle, Hoffman, Voelbel, Mason and Gette. Ms. Kelly has previously served on the board of directors for a public company and various industry groups and non-profit organizations.

Charles R. Nelson – Dr. Nelson is an experienced investment company trustee, having served on the Board, and the boards of predecessor funds, since 1981. Professor of Economics at the University of Washington since 1976, he has written several books, authored numerous articles in economics and finance, and served on editorial boards of professional journals. He is a Fellow of the Econometric Society and his contributions were the subject of a conference at the Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta in 2006. Additionally, he is an experienced consultant on economic and statistical matters.

John J. Neuhauser – Dr. Neuhauser is an experienced investment company trustee, having served on the Board since 1985 and on the boards of other investment companies. In addition to his board experience, Dr. Neuhauser has extensive executive experience. He is currently the President of Saint Michael’s College and has served in a variety of other leadership roles in higher education.

Jonathan Piel – Mr. Piel has served since 1994 as a trustee of mutual funds advised successively by U.S. Trust, Charles Schwab and the Adviser. In addition to this significant oversight experience he was the Editor of Scientific American and a vice president of Scientific American, Inc. He is also a member of the board of several not-for-profit organizations.

Patrick J. Simpson – Mr. Simpson is a partner at the law firm Perkins Coie L.L.P. Mr. Simpson’s practice includes such relevant areas as corporate governance and securities compliance.

Anne-Lee Verville – Ms. Verville has significant executive experience. Prior to her retirement in 1997, she held various leadership and executive roles with IBM Corporation. Ms. Verville has previously served on the board of directors for a public company and non-profit organizations.

William E. Mayer – Mr. Mayer has significant executive and board experience with financial services and investment companies. Mr. Mayer, currently a partner at a private equity firm, also has significant executive experience and experience working in finance. Previously, Mr. Mayer was a professor and Dean of the College of Business and Management at the University of Maryland and was President and CEO of The First Boston Corporation.

 

104


Table of Contents

 

The following table provides additional biographical information about the Trustees as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period. The mailing address of each Trustee is: c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, One Financial Center, Mail Stop MA5-515-11-05, Boston, MA 02111.

Independent Trustee Biographical Information

 

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

Rodman L. Drake
(Born 1943)
Trustee and Chairman of the Board
     1994       Independent consultant since 2010; Co-Founder of Baringo Capital LLC (private equity) from 1997 to 2008; CEO of Crystal River Capital, Inc. (real estate investment trust) from 2003 to 2010      64       Jackson Hewitt Tax Service Inc. (tax preparation services); Student Loan Corporation (student loan provider); Celgene Corporation (global biotechnology company); Crystal River Capital, Inc. from 2005 to 2010; Parsons Brinckerhoff from 1995-2008; and The Helios Funds (exchange-traded funds); Apex Silver Mines Ltd. from 2007 to 2009
John D. Collins
(Born 1938)
Trustee
     2005       Retired. Consultant, KPMG, LLP (accounting and tax firm) from July 1999 to June 2000; Partner, KPMG, LLP (accounting and tax firm) from March 1962 to June 1999      64       Mrs. Fields Original Cookies, Inc. (consumer products); Suburban Propane Partners, L.P.; and Montpelier Re (insurance underwriting firm)
Douglas A. Hacker
(Born 1955)
Trustee
     1996       Independent business executive since May 2006; Executive Vice President – Strategy of United Airlines from December 2002 to May 2006; President of UAL Loyalty Services (airline marketing company) from September 2001 to December 2002; Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of United Airlines from July 1999 to September 2001      64       Nash Finch Company (food distributor) and Aircastle Limited (aircraft leasing)

 

105


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

Janet Langford Kelly
(Born 1957)
Trustee
     1996       Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary, ConocoPhillips (integrated energy company) since September 2007; Deputy General Counsel – Corporate Legal Services, ConocoPhillips from August 2006 to August 2007; Partner, Zelle, Hofmann, Voelbel, Mason & Gette LLP (law firm) from March 2005 to July 2006; Adjunct Professor of Law, Northwestern University from September 2004 to June 2006; Director, UAL Corporation (airline) from February 2006 to July 2006; Chief Administrative Officer and Senior Vice President, Kmart Holding Corporation (consumer goods) from September 2003 to March 2004      64       None
Charles R. Nelson
(Born 1942)
Trustee
     1981       Professor of Economics, University of Washington since January 1976; Ford and Louisa Van Voorhis Professor of Political Economy, University of Washington since September 1993; Adjunct Professor of Statistics, University of Washington since September 1980; Associate Editor, Journal of Money, Credit and Banking from September 1993 to 2008; consultant on econometric and statistical matters      64       None

 

106


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

John J. Neuhauser
(Born 1943)
Trustee
     1984       President, Saint Michael’s College, since August 2007; University Professor, Boston College from November 2005 to August 2007; Director or Trustee of several non-profit organizations, including Fletcher Allen Health Care, Inc.; Academic Vice President and Dean of Faculties, Boston College from August 1999 to October 2005      64       Liberty All-Star Equity Fund and Liberty All-Star Growth Fund, Inc. (closed-end funds)
Jonathan Piel
(Born 1938)
Trustee
     1994       Cable television producer and web site designer; The Editor, Scientific American from 1984 to 1994; Vice President, Scientific American, Inc. from 1984 to 1994; Member, Advisory Board, Stone Age Institute, Bloomington, Indiana (research institute that explores the effect of technology on human evolution); Member, Board of Directors of the National Institute of Social Sciences, New York City; Member, Board of Trustees of the William Alanson White Institute, New York City (institution for training psychoanalysts); Member, Advisory Board, Mount Sinai Children’s Environmental Health Center, New York      64       None
Patrick J. Simpson
(Born 1944)
Trustee
     2000       Partner, Perkins Coie L.L.P. (law firm)      64       None

 

107


Table of Contents

Name, Year of Birth
and Position Held with

the Trust

   Year First Appointed
or Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia Funds
Complex or a
Predecessor Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During the

Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships Held by
Trustee
During the

Past Five Years

Anne-Lee Verville
(Born 1945)
Trustee
     1998       Retired since 1997 (formerly, General Manager, Global Education Industry from 1994 to 1997; President – Application Systems Division from 1991 to 1994; Chief Financial Officer – US Marketing & Services from 1988 to 1991; and Chief Information Officer from 1987 to 1988, IBM Corporation (computer and technology))      64       Enesco Group, Inc. (producer of giftware and home and garden decor products) from 2001 to 2006

Interested Trustee Biographical Information

 

Name, Year of
Birth and Position
Held with the Trust

   Year First
Appointed or
Elected as Trustee
to any Fund
Currently in the
Columbia
Funds Complex
or a Predecessor
Thereof
    

Principal
Occupation(s) During
the Past Five Years

   Number of
Funds in
the
Columbia
Funds
Complex
Overseen
    

Other Directorships

Held by Trustee During the
Past Five Years

William E. Mayer *
(Born 1940)
Trustee
     1994       Partner, Park Avenue Equity Partners (private equity) since February 1999; Dean and Professor, College of Business and Management University of Maryland from 1992 to 1996      64       DynaVox Inc. (software developer); Lee Enterprises (print media); WR Hambrecht + Co. (financial service provider); and BlackRock Kelso Capital Corporation (investment company)

 

* Mr. Mayer may technically be an “interested person” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Columbia Funds by reason of his affiliation with WR Hambrecht + Co., a registered broker/dealer that may execute portfolio transactions for, engage in principal transactions with, or distribute shares of a Fund or other funds or accounts advised/managed by the Adviser or any subadviser to a Fund.

 

108


Table of Contents

 

Compensation

Trustees are compensated for their services to the Columbia Funds complex on a complex-wide basis, as shown in the table below.

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund
Independent Trustees
 

Fund

  Rodman  L.
Drake(1)
    John D.
Collins(2)
    Douglas A.
Hacker
    Janet
Langford
Kelly
    Charles R.
Nelson
    John J.
Neuhauser
    Jonathan
Piel
    Patrick J.
Simpson(3)
    Thomas C.
Theobald(4)
    Anne-Lee
Verville(5)
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

  

Bond Fund

  $ 4,544      $ 3,582      $ 3,867      $ 3,600      $ 3,820      $ 3,533      $ 3,305      $ 3,599      $ 3,154      $ 3,739   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,526      $ 1,590      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,599      $ 0      $ 0   

Corporate Income Fund

  $ 4,205      $ 3,321      $ 3,586      $ 3,337      $ 3,547      $ 3,276      $ 3,065      $ 3,337      $ 2,923      $ 3,469   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,416      $ 1,480      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,337      $ 0      $ 0   

Emerging Markets Fund

  $ 3,100      $ 2,472      $ 2,678      $ 3,099      $ 1,969      $ 2,446      $ 2,292      $ 2,355      $ 2,172      $ 2,601   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,060      $ 2,188      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,355      $ 0      $ 0   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

  $ 3,888      $ 3,086      $ 3,341      $ 1,920      $ 2,671      $ 3,060      $ 2,868      $ 2,977      $ 2,691      $ 3,250   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,575      $ 2,738      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,977      $ 0      $ 0   

Intermediate Bond Fund

  $ 13,357      $ 10,532      $ 11,358      $ 10,581      $ 11,198      $ 10,374      $ 9,698      $ 10,555      $ 9,353      $ 10,967   

Amount deferred

  $ 4,491      $ 4,604      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 10,555      $ 0      $ 0   

Pacific/Asia Fund

  $ 1,588      $ 1,260      $ 1,363      $ 1,267      $ 1,353      $ 1,244      $ 1,165      $ 1,306      $ 1,104      $ 1,320   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,060      $ 1,118      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,306      $ 0      $ 0   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  $ 7,034      $ 5,587      $ 6,059      $ 5,625      $ 6,079      $ 5,569      $ 5,226      $ 4,880      $ 4,870      $ 5,919   

Amount deferred

  $ 4,591      $ 4,937      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,880      $ 0      $ 0   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

  $ 3,628      $ 2,846      $ 3,067      $ 2,854      $ 3,008      $ 2,789      $ 2,606      $ 2,836      $ 2,471      $ 2,947   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,204      $ 1,262      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,836      $ 0      $ 0   

Value and Restructuring Fund

  $ 33,775      $ 26,803      $ 28,951      $ 26,950      $ 28,828      $ 26,576      $ 24,874      $ 22,548      $ 23,966      $ 28,137   

Amount deferred

  $ 11,452      $ 11,817      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 22,548      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending May 31

  

High Yield Opportunity Fund

  $ 3,616      $ 2,742      $ 2,978      $ 2,763      $ 2,945      $ 2,686      $ 2,524      $ 2,760      $ 1,652      $ 2,845   

Amount deferred

  $ 920      $ 1,437      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,760      $ 0      $ 0   

International Bond Fund

  $ 1,694      $ 1,286      $ 1,399      $ 1,297      $ 1,088      $ 1,038      $ 962      $ 1,037      $ 541      $ 1,076   

Amount deferred

  $ 429      $ 676      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,037      $ 0      $ 0   

Strategic Income Fund

  $ 13,920      $ 10,524      $ 11,407      $ 10,585      $ 11,283      $ 10,309      $ 9,680      $ 10,576      $ 6,427      $ 10,914   

Amount deferred

  $ 3,532      $ 5,457      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 10,576      $ 0      $ 0   

 

109


Table of Contents
    Aggregate Compensation from Fund
Independent Trustees
 

Fund

  Rodman  L.
Drake(1)
    John D.
Collins(2)
    Douglas A.
Hacker
    Janet
Langford
Kelly
    Charles R.
Nelson
    John J.
Neuhauser
    Jonathan
Piel
    Patrick J.
Simpson(3)
    Thomas C.
Theobald(4)
    Anne-Lee
Verville(5)
 

For Funds with fiscal year ending June 30

  

High Yield Municipal Fund

  $ 4,982      $ 3,854      $ 4,247      $ 3,862      $ 4,118      $ 3,778      $ 3,555      $ 3,834      $ 2,098      $ 3,967   

Amount deferred.

  $ 1,903      $ 2,066      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,834      $ 0      $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund I

  $ 7,259      $ 5,618      $ 6,198      $ 5,619      $ 6,047      $ 5,539      $ 5,214      $ 5,618      $ 2,833      $ 5,818   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,497      $ 3,019      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 5,618      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending August 31

  

Balanced Fund

  $ 3,975      $ 2,999      $ 3,314      $ 2,993      $ 2,802      $ 2,560      $ 2,403      $ 2,557      $ 1,014      $ 3,524   

Amount deferred

  $ 370      $ 1,464      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,557      $ 0      $ 0   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

  $ 7,404      $ 5,624      $ 6,239      $ 5,647      $ 6,036      $ 5,541      $ 5,190      $ 5,520      $ 1,875      $ 5,787   

Amount deferred

  $ 982      $ 2,814      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 5,520      $ 0      $ 0   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

  $ 4,817      $ 3,671      $ 4,077      $ 3,679      $ 3,937      $ 3,617      $ 3,391      $ 3,598      $ 1,117      $ 3,768   

Amount deferred

  $ 602      $ 1,862      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,598      $ 0      $ 0   

Strategic Investor Fund

  $ 5,856      $ 4,446      $ 4,931      $ 4,467      $ 4,774      $ 4,381      $ 4,103      $ 4,366      $ 1,518      $ 4,578   

Amount deferred

  $ 791      $ 2,220      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,366      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending September 30

  

Contrarian Core Fund

  $ 2,386      $ 2,052      $ 2,262      $ 2,208      $ 2,360      $ 2,177      $ 2,046      $ 2,209      $ 2,702      $ 2,287   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,431      $ 1,170      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,209      $ 493      $ 0   

Dividend Income Fund

  $ 5,256      $ 4,430      $ 4,869      $ 4,728      $ 5,092      $ 4,719      $ 4,423      $ 4,782      $ 5,728      $ 4,953   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,192      $ 2,131      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,782      $ 0      $ 0   

Large Cap Growth Fund

  $ 6,532      $ 5,645      $ 6,229      $ 6,083      $ 6,490      $ 5,994      $ 5,632      $ 6,069      $ 7,509      $ 6,288   

Amount deferred

  $ 2,868      $ 2,788      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 6,069      $ 0      $ 0   

Small Cap Core Fund

  $ 3,483      $ 3,044      $ 3,368      $ 3,299      $ 3,550      $ 3,262      $ 3,070      $ 3,309      $ 4,132      $ 3,430   

Amount deferred

  $ 1,561      $ 1,519      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,309      $ 0      $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending October 31

  

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

  $ 1,666      $ 1,331      $ 1,452      $ 1,401      $ 1,491      $ 1,388      $ 1,294      $ 1,397      $ 1,546      $ 1,447   

Amount deferred

  $ 663      $ 638      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,397      $ 0      $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal period ended December 31, 2009 and fiscal year ended August 31, 2009, respectively

  

Real Estate Equity Fund

  $ 868      $ 694      $ 792      $ 735      $ 783      $ 695      $ 660      $ 707      $ 508      $ 745   

Amount deferred

  $ 929      $ 903      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,952      $ 0      $ 0   

Real Estate Equity Fund

  $ 2,108      $ 1,822      $ 1,998      $ 1,950      $ 2,086      $ 1,938      $ 1,821      $ 1,952      $ 2,057      $ 2,021   

Amount deferred

  $ 397      $ 412      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 707      $ 0      $ 0   

 

1

During the calendar year December 31, 2009, Mr. Drake deferred $116,500 of his total compensation from the Columbia Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Drake’s account under that plan was $223,507.

 

110


Table of Contents
2

During the calendar year December 31, 2009, Mr. Collins deferred $116,000 of his total compensation from the Columbia Fund Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Collins’ account under that plan was $205,097.

3

During the calendar year ended December 31, 2009, Mr. Simpson deferred $236,000 of his total compensation from the Columbia Funds Complex pursuant to the deferred compensation plan. At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Simpson’s account under that plan was $1,051,968.

4

At December 31, 2009, the value of Mr. Theobald’s account under the deferred compensation plan was $600,183. Mr. Theobald served as a Trustee of the Trust until February 2010.

5

At December 31, 2009, the value of Ms. Verville’s account under the deferred compensation plan was $679,903.

 

Aggregate Compensation from Fund   
     Interested Trustee  

Fund

   William E. Mayer  

For Funds with fiscal year ending March 31

  

Bond Fund

   $ 3,532   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Corporate Income Fund

   $ 3,277   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Emerging Markets Fund

   $ 2,453   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   $ 3,069   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Intermediate Bond Fund

   $ 10,361   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Pacific/Asia Fund

   $ 1,247   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 5,602   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

   $ 2,780   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Value and Restructuring Fund

   $ 26,607   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending May 31

  

High Yield Opportunity Fund

   $ 2,716   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

International Bond Fund

   $ 1,016   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Strategic Income Fund

   $ 10,405   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending June 30

  

High Yield Municipal Fund

   $ 3,813   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund I

   $ 5,604   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending August 31

  

Balanced Fund

   $ 3,040   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   $ 5,581   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   $ 3,649   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Strategic Investor Fund

   $ 4,411   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

 

111


Table of Contents
     Interested Trustee  

Fund

   William E. Mayer  

For Funds with fiscal year ending September 30

  

Contrarian Core Fund

   $ 2,121   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Dividend Income Fund

   $ 4,604   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 5,829   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Small Cap Core Fund

   $ 3,171   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For Funds with fiscal year ending October 31

  

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   $ 1,388   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal year ended August 31, 2009 and fiscal period ended December 31, 2009, respectively

   

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 1,887   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 707   

Amount deferred

   $ 0   

Independent Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Name of Trustee

   Total Compensation from the Columbia
Funds Complex Paid to  Independent Trustees
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a
 

Rodman L. Drake

   $ 275,955   

John D. Collins

   $ 226,990   

Douglas A. Hacker

   $ 251,005   

Janet Langford Kelly

   $ 234,000   

Charles R. Nelson

   $ 249,500   

John J. Neuhauser

   $ 233,500   

Jonathan Piel

   $ 218,500   

Patrick J. Simpson

   $ 236,000   

Thomas C. Theobaldb

   $ 248,550   

Anne-Lee Verville

   $ 244,000   

 

a

All Trustees receive reimbursements for reasonable expenses related to their attendance at meetings of the Board or standing committees, which are not included in the amounts shown.

b

Mr. Theobald served as a Trustee of the Trust until February 2010.

Interested Trustee Compensation for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Name of Trustee

   Total Compensation from the Columbia
Funds Complex Paid to Interested Trustee
for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009a
 

William E. Mayer

   $ 233,500   

 

a

Mr. Mayer receives reimbursements for reasonable expenses related to his attendance at meetings of the Board or standing committees, which are not included in the amounts shown.

 

112


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Funds Deferred Compensation Plan

Under the terms of the Deferred Fee Agreement (the Deferred Compensation Plan), each eligible Trustee may elect, on an annual basis, to defer receipt of all or a portion of compensation payable to him or her for service as Trustee for that calendar year (expressly, a Trustee may elect to defer his/her annual retainer, his/her attendance fees, or both components, which together comprise total compensation for service). Fees deferred by a Trustee are credited to a book reserve account (the Deferral Account) established by the Columbia Funds, the value of which is derived from the rate of return of one or more Columbia Funds selected by the Trustee (with accruals to the Deferral Account beginning at such time as a Trustee’s fund elections having been established, and proceeds for service having been paid into such account, and terminating at such time as when proceeds become payable to such Trustee under the Deferred Compensation Plan). Trustees may change their fund elections only in accordance with the provisions of the Deferred Compensation Plan.

Distributions from a Trustee’s Deferral Account will be paid by check, either in a lump sum or in annual installments. Payments made in annual installments are disbursed over a period of up to ten years, following such time as a Trustee may qualify to receive such payments. If a deferring Trustee dies prior to or after the commencement of the disbursement of amounts accrued in his/her Deferral Account, the balance of the account will be distributed to his/her designated beneficiary either in lump sum or in annual payments as established by such Trustee himself/herself, his/her beneficiary or his/her estate. Amounts payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan are not funded or secured in any way, and each deferring Trustee has the status of an unsecured creditor of the Columbia Fund(s) from which compensation has been deferred.

Beneficial Equity Ownership

As of the date of this SAI, the Trustees and Officers of the Trust, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of each class of shares of each Fund. The table below shows, for each Trustee, the amount of Fund equity securities beneficially owned by the Trustee and the aggregate value of all investments in equity securities of the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustee, stated as one of the following ranges: A = $0; B = $1-$10,000; C = $10,001-$50,000; D = $50,001-$100,000; and E = over $100,000.

Independent Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   John D.
Collins
     Rodman L.
Drake
    Douglas A.
Hacker
     Janet Langford
Kelly
     Charles R.
Nelson
 

Balanced Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Bond Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Contrarian Core Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Corporate Income Fund

     A         A        A         A         E   

Dividend Income Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Emerging Markets Fund

     C         C 1      E         A         A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

High Yield Municipal Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     A         A        E         A         D   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     A         A        A         A         E   

International Bond Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Large Cap Growth Fund

     A         A        A         A         D   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     A         A        A         E         E   

Pacific/Asia Fund

     C         A        A         A         A   

Real Estate Equity Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     C         D 1      A         A         A   

Small Cap Core Fund

     A         A        A         A         A   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     A         A        A         A         A   

 

113


Table of Contents

Fund

   John D.
Collins
    Rodman L.
Drake
    Douglas A.
Hacker
     Janet Langford
Kelly
     Charles R.
Nelson
 

Small Cap Value Fund I

     A        A        A         A         A   

Strategic Income Fund

     E        D 1      E         E         E   

Strategic Investor Fund

     A        A        A         C         A   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     A        A        A         A         A   

Value and Restructuring Fund

     C 1      C 1      A         A         A   

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

     E 1      E 1      E         E         E   

 

1

Includes the value of compensation payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan that is determined as if the amounts deferred had been invested, as of the date of deferral, in shares of one or more funds in the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustee as specified by each Trustee.

Independent Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   John J.
Neuhauser
     Jonathan
Piel
     Patrick J
Simpson
    Anne–Lee
Verville
 

Balanced Fund

     A         A         C        A   

Bond Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Contrarian Core Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Corporate Income Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Dividend Income Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Emerging Markets Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     A         A         A        A   

High Yield Municipal Fund

     A         A         A        A   

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     A         A         A        A   

International Bond Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Large Cap Growth Fund

     A         A         D        A   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     A         A         C        A   

Pacific/Asia Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Real Estate Equity Fund

     A         A         C        A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Small Cap Core Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     A         A         A        A   

Small Cap Value Fund I

     D         A         A        A   

Strategic Income Fund

     E         A         E        E 1 

Strategic Investor Fund

     A         A         A        A   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Value and Restructuring Fund

     A         A         A        A   

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

     E         A         E 1      E 1 

 

1

Includes the value of compensation payable under the Deferred Compensation Plan that is determined as if the amounts deferred had been invested, as of the date of deferral, in shares of one or more funds in the Columbia Funds Family overseen by the Trustee as specified by each Trustee.

 

114


Table of Contents

 

Interested Trustee Ownership for the Calendar Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

Fund

   William E. Mayer  

Balanced Fund

     A   

Bond Fund

     A   

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     A   

Contrarian Core Fund

     A   

Corporate Income Fund

     A   

Dividend Income Fund

     A   

Emerging Markets Fund

     A   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

     A   

High Yield Municipal Fund

     A   

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     A   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     A   

International Bond Fund

     A   

Large Cap Growth Fund

     A   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

     A   

Pacific/Asia Fund

     A   

Real Estate Equity Fund

     A   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

     A   

Small Cap Core Fund

     A   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

     A   

Small Cap Value Fund I

     A   

Strategic Income Fund

     A   

Strategic Investor Fund

     A   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     A   

Value and Restructuring Fund

     A   

Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities in all Funds in the Columbia Funds Family Overseen by the Trustee

     A   

 

115


Table of Contents

 

The Officers

The following table provides basic information about the Officers of the Trust as of the date of this SAI, including their principal occupations during the past five years, although their specific titles may have varied over the period. The mailing address of each Officer is: c/o Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, One Financial Center, Mail Stop MA5-515-11-05, Boston, MA 02111.

Officer Biographical Information

 

Name and

Year of Birth

   Position with  the
Trust
   Year First Elected or
Appointed to
Office
    

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

J. Kevin Connaughton

(Born 1964)

   President      2009       Senior Vice President and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President, Columbia Funds, since 2009, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010 (previously Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Columbia Funds, from June 2008 to January 2009, Treasurer, Columbia Funds, from October 2003 to May 2008, and senior officer of various other affiliated funds since 2000); Managing Director, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from December 2004 to April 2010.
Michael G. Clarke
(Born 1969)
   Senior Vice President
and Chief Financial
Officer
     2009       Vice President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Managing Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from September 2004 to April 2010; senior officer of Columbia Funds and affiliated funds since 2002.
Scott R. Plummer
(Born 1959)
   Senior Vice President,
Secretary and Chief
Legal Officer
     2010       Chief Legal Officer and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since June 2005; Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, from 2005 to April 2010, and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance from 2004 to 2005); Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, RiverSource Funds, since December 2006; Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Columbia Funds, since May 2010.

 

116


Table of Contents

Name and

Year of Birth

   Position with  the
Trust
   Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office
    

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

Linda J. Wondrack
(Born 1964)
   Senior Vice President
and Chief Compliance
Officer
     2007       Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Funds, since 2007, and RiverSource Funds, since May 2010; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, from June 2005 to April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer of MFS Investment Management (investment management) from August 2004 to May 2005.
William F. Truscott
(Born 1960)
   Senior Vice President      2010       Chairman of the Board, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to April 2010); Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President, Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer from 2005 to April 2010, and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, from 2001 to 2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer from 2008 to April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006.

Colin Moore

(Born 1958)

   Senior Vice President      2010       Director and Chief Investment Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2002 to 2007.

 

117


Table of Contents

Name and

Year of Birth

   Position with  the
Trust
   Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

Michael A. Jones
(Born 1959)
   Senior Vice President    2010    Director and President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from 2007 to April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from November 2006 to April 2010; previously, co-president and senior managing director at Robeco Investment Management.

Amy Johnson

(Born 1965)

   Senior Vice President    2010    Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010 (previously Chief Administrative Officer, from 2009 until April 2010, Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, from 2006 to 2009, and Vice President – Operations and Compliance from 2004 to 2006).
Joseph F. DiMaria
(Born 1968)
   Treasurer and Chief
Accounting Officer
   Treasurer since
2009 and Chief
Accounting Officer
since 2008
   Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2006 to April 2010; Head of Tax/Compliance and Assistant Treasurer, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from November 2004 to December 2005.
Marybeth Pilat
(Born 1968)
   Deputy Treasurer    2010    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, since May 2010; Vice President, Investment Operations, Bank of America, from October 2008 to April 2010; Finance Manager, Boston Children’s Hospital from August 2008 to October 2008; Director, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from May 2007 to July 2008; Vice President, Mutual Fund Valuation, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from January 2006 to May 2007; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from January 2005 to January 2006.

 

118


Table of Contents

Name and

Year of Birth

  

Position with the
Trust

   Year First Elected or
Appointed to Office
  

Principal Occupation(s)
During the Past Five Years

Julian Quero
(Born 1967)
   Deputy Treasurer    2008    Vice President, Mutual Fund Administration, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Director of Fund Administration, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, from August 2008 to April 2010; Senior Tax Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from August 2006 to July 2008; Senior Compliance Manager, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC from April 2002 to August 2006.

Kathryn Thompson

(Born 1967)

   Assistant Treasurer    2006    Director, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight and Treasury of the Adviser, since May 2010; Vice President, Mutual Fund Accounting Oversight of the Previous Adviser from December 2004 to April 2010; Vice President, State Street Corporation (financial services) prior to December 2004.

Stephen T. Welsh

(Born 1957)

   Vice President    2006    President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Services, Inc. from July 2004 to April 2010; Managing Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc. from August 2007 to April 2010.
Paul B. Goucher
(Born 1968)
   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel of Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel from November 2008 to January 2010); Director, Managing Director and General Counsel of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated (Seligman) from July 2008 to November 2008 and Managing Director and Associate General Counsel of Seligman from January 2005 to July 2008.

Christopher O. Petersen

(Born 1970)

   Assistant Secretary    2010    Vice President and Chief Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since January 2010 (formerly Vice President and Group Counsel or Counsel from April 2004 to January 2010); Assistant Secretary of RiverSource Funds since January 2007.
Ryan C. Larrenaga
(Born 1970)
   Assistant Secretary    2005    Counsel, Ameriprise Financial since May 2010; Assistant General Counsel, Bank of America from March 2005 to April 2010; Associate, Ropes & Gray LLP (law firm) from 1998 to February 2005.

 

119


Table of Contents

 

BROKERAGE ALLOCATION AND OTHER PRACTICES

General Brokerage Policy, Brokerage Transactions and Broker Selection

Subject to policies established by the Board, the Adviser (or the investment subadviser(s) who make the day-to-day investment decisions for a Fund, as applicable) is responsible for decisions to buy and sell securities for each Fund, for the selection of broker/dealers, for the execution of a Fund’s securities transactions and for the allocation of brokerage commissions in connection with such transactions. The Adviser’s primary consideration in effecting a security transaction is to obtain the best net price and the most favorable execution of the order. Purchases and sales of securities on a securities exchange are effected through brokers who charge negotiated commissions for their services. Orders may be directed to any broker to the extent and in the manner permitted by applicable law.

In the over-the-counter market, securities generally are traded on a “net” basis with dealers acting as principals for their own accounts without stated commissions, although the price of a security usually includes a profit to the dealer. In underwritten offerings, securities are bought at a fixed price that includes an amount of compensation to the underwriter, generally referred to as the underwriter’s “concession” or “discount.” On occasion, certain money market instruments may be bought directly from an issuer, in which case no commissions or discounts are paid.

In placing orders for portfolio securities of the Funds, the Adviser gives primary consideration to obtaining the best net prices and most favorable execution. This means that the Adviser will seek to execute each transaction at a price and commission, if any, which provides the most favorable total cost or proceeds reasonably attainable in the circumstances. In seeking such execution, the Adviser will use its best judgment in evaluating the terms of a transaction, and will give consideration to various relevant factors, including, without limitation, the size and type of the transaction, the nature and character of the market for the security, the confidentiality, speed and certainty of effective execution required for the transaction, the general execution and operational capabilities of the broker/dealer, the reputation, reliability, experience and financial condition of the broker/dealer, the value and quality of the services rendered by the broker/dealer in this instance and other transactions and the reasonableness of the spread or commission, if any. Research services received from broker/dealers supplement the Adviser’s own research and may include the following types of information: statistical and background information on industry groups and individual companies; forecasts and interpretations with respect to U.S. and foreign economies, securities, markets, specific industry groups and individual companies; information on political developments; Fund management strategies; performance information on securities and information concerning prices of securities; and information supplied by specialized services to the Adviser and to the Board with respect to the performance, investment activities and fees and expenses of other mutual funds. Such information may be communicated electronically, orally or in written form. Research services also may include the arranging of meetings with management of companies and the provision of access to consultants who supply research information.

The outside research is useful to the Adviser since, in certain instances, the broker/dealers utilized by the Adviser may follow a different universe of securities issuers and other matters than those that the Adviser’s staff can follow. In addition, this research provides the Adviser with a different perspective on financial markets, even if the securities research obtained relates to issues followed by the Adviser. Research services that are provided to the Adviser by broker/dealers are available for the benefit of all accounts managed or advised by the Adviser. In some cases, the research services are available only from the broker/dealer providing such services. In other cases, the research services may be obtainable from alternative sources. The Adviser is of the opinion that because the broker/dealer research supplements rather than replaces the Adviser’s own research, the receipt of such research does not tend to decrease the Adviser’s expenses, but tends to improve the quality of its investment advice. However, to the extent that the Adviser would have bought any such research services had such services not been provided by broker/dealers, the expenses of such services to the Adviser could be considered to have been reduced accordingly. Certain research services furnished by broker/dealers may be useful to the clients of the Adviser other than the Funds. Conversely, any research services received by the Adviser through the

 

120


Table of Contents

placement of transactions of other clients may be of value to the Adviser in fulfilling its obligations to the Funds. The Adviser is of the opinion that this material is beneficial in supplementing its research and analysis; and, therefore, it may benefit the Trust by improving the quality of the Adviser’s investment advice. The advisory fees paid by the Trust are not reduced because the Adviser receives such services.

Under Section 28(e) of the 1934 Act, the Adviser shall not be “deemed to have acted unlawfully or to have breached its fiduciary duty” solely because under certain circumstances it has caused the account to pay a higher commission than the lowest available. To obtain the benefit of Section 28(e), the Adviser must make a good faith determination that the commissions paid are “reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage and research services provided by such member, broker, or dealer, viewed in terms of either that particular transaction or his overall responsibilities with respect to the accounts as to which he exercises investment discretion.” Accordingly, the price to a Funds in any transaction may be less favorable than that available from another broker/dealer if the difference is reasonably justified by other aspects of the portfolio execution services offered. Some broker/dealers may indicate that the provision of research services is dependent upon the generation of certain specified levels of commissions and underwriting concessions by the Adviser’s clients, including the Funds.

Commission rates are established pursuant to negotiations with broker/dealers based on the quality and quantity of execution services provided by broker/dealers in light of generally prevailing rates. On exchanges on which commissions are negotiated, the cost of transactions may vary among different broker/dealers. Transactions on foreign stock exchanges involve payment of brokerage commissions that generally are fixed. Transactions in both foreign and domestic over-the-counter markets generally are principal transactions with dealers, and the costs of such transactions involve dealer spreads rather than brokerage commissions. With respect to over-the-counter transactions, the Adviser, where possible, will deal directly with dealers who make a market in the securities involved, except in those circumstances in which better prices and execution are available elsewhere.

In certain instances there may be securities that are suitable for a Fund as well as for one or more of the other clients of the Adviser. Investment decisions for the Funds and for the Adviser’s other clients are made with the goal of achieving their respective investment objectives. A particular security may be bought or sold for only one client even though it may be held by, or bought or sold for, other clients. Likewise, a particular security may be bought for one or more clients when one or more other clients are selling that same security. Some simultaneous transactions are inevitable when a number of accounts receive investment advice from the same investment adviser, particularly when the same security is suitable for the investment objectives of more than one client. When two or more clients are engaged simultaneously in the purchase or sale of the same security, the securities are allocated among clients in a manner believed to be equitable to each. In some cases, this policy could have a detrimental effect on the price or volume of the security in a particular transaction that may affect the Funds.

The Funds may participate, if and when practicable, in bidding for the purchase of portfolio securities directly from an issuer in order to take advantage of the lower purchase price available to members of a bidding group. A Fund will engage in this practice, however, only when the Adviser, in its sole discretion, believes such practice to be otherwise in such Fund’s interests.

The Trust will not execute portfolio transactions through, or buy or sell portfolio securities from or to, the Distributor, the Adviser, the Administrator or their affiliates acting as principal (including repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements), except to the extent permitted by applicable law, regulation or order. However, the Adviser is authorized to allocate buy and sell orders for portfolio securities to certain broker/dealers and financial institutions, including, in the case of agency transactions, broker/dealers and financial institutions that are affiliated with Ameriprise Financial. To the extent that a Fund executes any securities trades with an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial, such Fund does so in conformity with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act and the procedures that such Fund has adopted pursuant to the rule. In this regard, for each transaction, the Board will determine that: (i) the transaction resulted in prices for and execution of securities transactions at least as favorable to the particular Fund as those likely to be derived from a non-affiliated qualified broker/dealer; (ii) the affiliated broker/dealer charged the Fund commission rates consistent with those charged by the affiliated broker/dealer in similar transactions to clients comparable to the Fund and that are not affiliated with the broker/dealer in

 

121


Table of Contents

question; and (iii) the fees, commissions or other remuneration paid by the Fund did not exceed 2% of the sales price of the securities if the sale was effected in connection with a secondary distribution, or 1% of the purchase or sale price of such securities if effected in other than a secondary distribution.

Certain affiliates of Ameriprise Financial may have deposit, loan or commercial banking relationships with the corporate users of facilities financed by industrial development revenue bonds or private activity bonds bought by certain of the Columbia Funds. Ameriprise Financial or certain of its affiliates may serve as trustee, custodian, tender agent, guarantor, placement agent, underwriter, or in some other capacity, with respect to certain issues of securities. Under certain circumstances, a Fund may buy securities from a member of an underwriting syndicate in which an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial is a member. The Trust has adopted procedures pursuant to Rule 10f-3 under the 1940 Act, and intends to comply with the requirements of Rule 10f-3, in connection with any purchases of municipal securities that may be subject to Rule 10f-3.

Given the breadth of the Adviser’s investment management activities, investment decisions for the Funds are not always made independently from those for other funds, or other investment companies and accounts advised or managed by the Adviser. When a purchase or sale of the same security is made at substantially the same time on behalf of one or more of the Columbia Funds and another investment portfolio, investment company or account, the transaction will be averaged as to price and available investments allocated as to amount in a manner which the Adviser believes to be equitable to the Funds and such other funds, investment portfolio, investment company or account. In some instances, this investment procedure may adversely affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the position obtained or sold by the Fund. To the extent permitted by law, the Adviser may aggregate the securities to be sold or bought for the Funds with those to be sold or bought for other funds, investment portfolios, investment companies, or accounts in executing transactions.

See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information about these and other conflicts of interest.

Brokerage Commissions

The following charts reflect the amounts of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recently completed fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated. In certain instances, the Funds may pay brokerage commissions to broker/dealers that are affiliates of Ameriprise Financial. As indicated above, all such transactions involving the payment of brokerage commissions to affiliates are done in compliance with Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act.

Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds

The following charts reflect the aggregate amount of brokerage commissions paid by the Funds for the three most recent fiscal years, except as otherwise indicated. Differences, year to year, in the amount of brokerage commissions paid by a Fund were primarily the result of increased market volatility as well as shareholder purchase and redemption activity in the Fund.

 

Fund

  Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2010
    Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2009
    Fiscal Year Ended
March 31, 2008
 

Bond Fund

    —        $ 7,631      $ 1,313   

Corporate Income Fund

  $ 16,910      $ 40,205      $ 41,873   

Emerging Markets Fund

  $ 1,613,790      $ 1,857,556      $ 409,305   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

  $ 4,604,246      $ 4,051,236      $ 1,575,505   

Intermediate Bond Fund

  $ 72,932      $ 160,852      $ 251,534   

Pacific/Asia Fund

  $ 121,276      $ 249,437      $ 144,244   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  $ 1,269,007      $ 1,221,132      $ 399,105   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

    —          —          —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

  $ 2,433,201      $ 4,287,837      $ 2,688,134   

 

122


Table of Contents

Fund

  Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
    Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2009
    Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2008
 

High Yield Opportunity Fund

    —          —          —     

Strategic Income Fund

    —          —          —     

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
May 31, 2010
     Fiscal Period Ended
May 31, 2009
 

International Bond Fund

   $ 7,557         —     

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2010
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
June 30, 2008
 

High Yield Municipal Fund

     —         $ 7,745       $ 38,343   

Small Cap Value Fund I

   $ 1,771,335       $ 1,761,043       $ 1,768,277   

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2010*
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008
 

Balanced Fund

   $ 1,940       $ 358,996       $ 367   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   $ 3,436,137       $ 4,070,265       $ 4,499,159   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   $ 4,948,857       $ 2,979,089       $ 1,860,445   

Strategic Investor Fund

   $ 1,505,109       $ 2,168,357       $ 2,202,923   

 

* Unaudited.

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
September 30, 2007
 

Contrarian Core Fund

   $ 1,108,739       $ 837,955       $ 875,499   

Dividend Income Fund

   $ 1,224,272       $ 300,918       $ 252,732   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 3,113,714       $ 3,752,464       $ 4,695,947   

Small Cap Core Fund

   $ 401,075       $ 783,011       $ 1,357,590   

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
October 31, 2007
 

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   $ 215       $ 2,063.75       $ 5,041   

 

Fund

   Fiscal Period Ended
December 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2009
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2008
     Fiscal Year Ended
August 31, 2007
 

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 205,056       $ 770,227       $ 575,797       $ 1,245,494   

Brokerage Commissions Paid by the Funds to Certain Broker/Dealers

The Funds paid no brokerage commissions to affiliated broker/dealers for the three most recently completed fiscal years.

Directed Brokerage

The Funds or the Adviser, through an agreement or understanding with a broker/dealer, or otherwise through an internal allocation procedure, may direct, subject to applicable legal requirements, the Funds’ brokerage transactions to a broker/dealer because of the research services it provides the Funds or the Adviser.

 

123


Table of Contents

 

During each Fund’s last fiscal year, the Funds directed certain brokerage transactions and paid related commissions in the amounts as follows:

 

Fund

   Amount of
Transactions
     Related
Commissions
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

     

Bond Fund

     —           —     

Corporate Income Fund

     —           —     

Emerging Markets Fund

   $ 40,833,479       $ 96,869   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   $ 1,577,703,004       $ 1,174,934   

Intermediate Bond Fund

     —           —     

Pacific/Asia Fund

   $ 6,528,634       $ 16,526   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 215,687,831       $ 123,292   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

     —           —     

Value and Restructuring Fund

   $ 94,434,776       $ 109,144   

For Funds with fiscal year ended May 31, 2010

     

High Yield Opportunity Fund

     —           —     

Strategic Income Fund

     —           —     

International Bond Fund

     —           —     

For Funds with fiscal year ended June 30, 2010

     

High Yield Municipal Fund

     —           —     

Small Cap Value Fund I

   $ 243,711,788       $ 379,141   

For Funds with fiscal year ended August 31, 2010*

     

Balanced Fund

     —           —     

Mid Cap Growth Fund

   $ 883,671,820       $ 882,670   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

   $ 552,521,922       $ 755,567   

Strategic Investor Fund

   $ 352,498,218       $ 387,370   

For Funds with fiscal year ended September 30, 2009

     

Contrarian Core Fund

   $ 868,244,017       $ 158,344   

Dividend Income Fund

   $ 1,205,420,394       $ 245,382   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   $ 3,319,677,698       $ 317,931   

Small Cap Core Fund

   $ 123,921,233       $ 7,888   

For the Fund with fiscal year ended October 31, 2009

     

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

     —           —     

For the Fund with fiscal year ended August 31, 2009 and fiscal period ended December 31, 2009, respectively

     

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 548,639,648       $ 128,657   

Real Estate Equity Fund

   $ 176,752,302       $ 10,022   

 

* Unaudited.

Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

In certain cases, the Funds, as part of their principal investment strategies, or otherwise as a permissible investment, will invest in the common stock or debt obligations of the regular broker/dealers that the Adviser uses to transact brokerage for the Funds.

 

124


Table of Contents

 

As of each Fund’s fiscal year end, the Funds owned securities of their “regular brokers or dealers” or their parents, as defined in Rule 10b-1 under the 1940 Act, as shown in the table below:

Investments in Securities of Regular Broker/Dealers

 

Fund

  

Broker/Dealer

   Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended March 31, 2010

  

Bond Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc    $ 24,282,998   
   Barclays Capital    $ 847,993   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 3,211,139   
   Deutsche Bank AG    $ 819,793   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 8,744,405   
   UBS Warburg LLC    $ 9,489,194   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 3,182,799   

Corporate Income Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 3,407,339   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 10,063,708   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 626,052   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 12,494,578   

Emerging Markets Fund

   None    $ 0   

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

   None    $ 0   

Intermediate Bond Fund

   Barclays Capital    $ 2,552,425   
   Citigroup, Inc.    $ 41,593,132   
   CS First Boston Corp.    $ 33,863,433   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 21,911,658   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 72,066,818   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 39,657,747   

Pacific/Asia Fund

   None    $ 0   

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

   None    $ 0   

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

   None    $ 0   

Value and Restructuring Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 127,537,500   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 106,908,500   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 141,622,900   
   Citigroup, Inc    $ 22,547,800   

For Funds with fiscal year ended May 31, 2010

  

High Yield Opportunity Fund

   None    $ 0   

International Bond Fund

   None    $ 0   

Strategic Income Fund

   Citigroup, Inc    $ 21,350,102   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 12,268,572   
   Barclays Capital    $ 3,127,149   
   Deutsche Bank AG    $ 12,787,838   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 9,796,852   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 8,795,329   

For Funds with fiscal year ended June 30, 2010

  

High Yield Municipal Fund

   None    $ 0   

Small Cap Value Fund I

   Piper Jaffray Companies, Inc.    $ 6,315,184   

 

125


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Broker/Dealer

   Dollar Amount of
Securities Held
 

For Funds with fiscal year ended August 31, 2010

  

Balanced Fund

  

Goldman Sachs & Co.

   $ 4,701,785   
  

State Street Corp.

   $ 2,838,147   
  

JPMorgan Chase & Co.

   $ 10,066,956   
  

Citigroup, Inc.

   $ 3,196,652   
  

Deutsche Bank AG

   $ 539,763   
  

Barclays Capital

   $ 561,638   
  

Salomon Brothers Holdings, Inc.

   $ 1,440,381   
  

CS First Boston Corp.

   $ 2,340,563   
  

Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.

   $ 2,559,873   
  

UBS Warburg LLC

   $ 1,720,960   
  

Royal Bank of Scotland PLC

   $ 430,160   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

  

None

   $ 0   

Small Cap Growth Fund I

  

None

   $ 0   

Strategic Investor Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 7,979,314   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 14,732,745   

For Funds with fiscal year ended September 30, 2009

  

Contrarian Core Fund

   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 6,768,896   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 11,790,735   
   State Street Corp.    $ 7,774,280   
   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 9,770,550   

Dividend Income Fund

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 47,544,700   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 17,910,400   

Large Cap Growth Fund

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 10,434,210   
   Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.    $ 19,525,424   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.    $ 9,644,782   

Small Cap Core Fund

   None    $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal year ended October 31, 2009

  

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

   None    $ 0   

For the Fund with fiscal period ended December 31, 2009

  

Real Estate Equity Fund

   None    $ 0   

Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments

The Funds, along with the Transfer Agent and/or the Distributor and the Adviser, may pay significant amounts to financial intermediaries (as defined below), including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for providing the types of services that would typically be provided directly by a mutual fund’s transfer agent. The level of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. A number of factors may be considered in determining payments to a financial intermediary, including, without limitation, the nature of the services provided to shareholders or retirement plan participants that invest in the Funds through retirement plans. These services may include sub-accounting, sub-transfer agency or similar recordkeeping services, shareholder or participant reporting, shareholder or participant transaction processing, and/or the provision of call center support (additional shareholder services). These payments for shareholder servicing support with respect to the Columbia Funds vary by financial intermediary but generally are not expected, with certain limited exceptions, to exceed 0.40% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan, and 0.45% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares in the program on an annual basis for those classes of shares that do not pay a service fee pursuant to a Rule 12b-1 Plan. The Board has authorized each Fund to pay up to 0.15% of the average aggregate value of each Fund’s shares. Such payments will be made by a Fund to the Transfer Agent who will in turn make payments to the financial intermediary for the provision of such additional shareholder services. The Funds’ Transfer Agent, Distributor or their affiliates will pay, from its or their own resources, amounts in excess of the amount paid by the Funds to financial intermediaries in connection with the provision of these additional shareholder services and other services.

 

126


Table of Contents

 

For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment advisor, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Funds also may make additional payments to financial intermediaries that charge networking fees for certain services provided in connection with the maintenance of shareholder accounts through the NSCC.

In addition, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may make lump sum payments to selected financial intermediaries receiving shareholder servicing payments in reimbursement of printing costs for literature for participants, account maintenance fees or fees for establishment of the Funds on the financial intermediary’s system or other similar services.

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates had agreed to make shareholder servicing payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

Recipients of Shareholder Servicing Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

Acclaim Benefits, Inc.

   

A.G. Edwards

   

Alerus Retirement Solutions

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Benefit Plan Administrators

   

Bisys Retirement Services

   

Charles Schwab & Co.

   

Charles Schwab Trust Co.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

CitiStreet LLC

   

City National Bank

   

Compensation & Capital Administrative Services, Inc.

   

CPI Qualified Plan Consultants

   

Daily Access Concepts, Inc.

   

Digital Retirement Solutions

   

Dreyfus

   

Edward D. Jones & Co., L.P.

   

E*Trade Group, Inc.

   

ExpertPlan

   

Fidelity Investments Institutional Operations Co.

   

First Clearing LLC

   

Genworth Financial

   

GPC Securities, Inc.

   

Guardian Life Insurance Company

   

GWFS Equities, Inc.

   

Hartford Life Insurance Company

   

Hewitt Associates LLC

   

ICMA Retirement Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Company

   

ING Institutional Plan Services, LLP

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company (USA)

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company of New York

   

JP Morgan Retirement Plan Services LLC

   

Lincoln Financial Group

   

LPL Financial Corporation

   

Marshall & Illsley Trust Company

   

Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company

   

Matrix Settlement & Clearance Services

   

Mercer HR Services, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Mid Atlantic Capital Corporation

   

Morgan Keegan & Co., Inc.

   

Morgan Stanley & Co., Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Investor Services Corp.

   

Newport Retirement Services, Inc.

   

New York State Deferred Compensation Plan

   

NYLife Distributors LLC

   

PNC Advisors

   

Princeton Retirement Group

   

Principal Life Insurance Company

   

Prudential Insurance Company of America

   

Prudential Retirement Insurance & Annuity Co.

   

Reliance Trust Company


 

127


Table of Contents
   

Robert W. Baird & Co., Inc.

   

Royal Alliance Associates, Inc.

   

Standard Retirement Services, Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Clearing Inc.

   

TD Ameritrade Trust Company

   

Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association of America

   

The 401k Company

   

T. Rowe Price Group, Inc.

   

The Vanguard Group, Inc.

   

Unified Trust Company, N.A.

   

UPromise Investments, Inc.

   

VALIC Retirement Services

   

Wachovia Bank, N.A.

   

Wachovia Securities, LLC

   

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management, LLC

   

Wilmington Trust Corporation

   

Wilmington Trust Retirement & Institutional Services Company


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

Additional Financial Intermediary Payments

Financial intermediaries may receive different commissions, sales charge reallowances and other payments with respect to sales of different classes of shares of the Funds. These other payments may include servicing payments to retirement plan administrators and other institutions at rates up to those described above under Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. For purposes of this section the term “financial intermediary” includes any broker/dealer, bank, bank trust department, registered investment adviser, financial planner, retirement plan or other third party administrator and any other institution having a selling, services or any similar agreement with the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates.

The Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may pay additional compensation to selected financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, under the categories described below. These categories are not mutually exclusive, and a single financial intermediary may receive payments under all categories. A financial intermediary also may receive payments described above in Brokerage Allocation and Other Practices – Additional Shareholder Servicing Payments. These payments may create an incentive for a financial intermediary or its representatives to recommend or offer shares of a Fund to its customers. The amount of payments made to financial intermediaries may vary. In determining the amount of payments to be made, the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates may consider a number of factors, including, without limitation, asset mix and length of relationship with the financial intermediary, the size of the customer/shareholder base of the financial intermediary, the manner in which customers of the financial intermediary make investments in the Funds, the nature and scope of marketing support or services provided by the financial intermediary (as described more fully below) and the costs incurred by the financial intermediary in connection with maintaining the infrastructure necessary or desirable to support investments in the Funds.

These additional payments by the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates are made pursuant to agreements between the Distributor and other Ameriprise Financial affiliates and financial intermediaries, and do not change the price paid by investors for the purchase of a share, the amount a Fund will receive as proceeds from such sales or the distribution fees and expenses paid by the Fund as shown under the heading Fees and Expenses of the Fund in the Fund’s prospectuses.

Marketing Support Payments

The Distributor and the Adviser may make payments, from their own resources, to certain financial intermediaries, including other Ameriprise Financial affiliates, for marketing support services relating to the Columbia Funds, including, but not limited to, business planning assistance, educating financial intermediary

 

128


Table of Contents

personnel about the Funds and shareholder financial planning needs, placement on the financial intermediary’s preferred or recommended fund list or otherwise identifying the Funds as being part of a complex to be accorded a higher degree of marketing support than complexes not making such payments, access to sales meetings, sales representatives and management representatives of the financial intermediary, client servicing and systems infrastructure support. These payments are generally based upon one or more of the following factors: average net assets of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, gross sales of the Columbia Funds distributed by the Distributor attributable to that financial intermediary, reimbursement of ticket charges (fees that a financial intermediary firm charges its representatives for effecting transactions in fund shares) or a negotiated lump sum payment.

While the financial arrangements may vary for each financial intermediary, the marketing support payments to each financial intermediary generally are expected to be between 0.05% and 0.50% on an annual basis for payments based on average net assets of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary, and between 0.05% and 0.25% on an annual basis for firms receiving a payment based on gross sales of the Columbia Funds attributable to the financial intermediary. The Distributor and affiliates may make payments in materially larger amounts or on a basis materially different from those described above when dealing with certain financial intermediaries. Such increased payments may enable the financial intermediaries to offset credits that they may provide to their customers.

As of the date of this SAI, the Distributor and/or the Adviser had agreed to make marketing support payments with respect to the Columbia Funds to the financial intermediaries or their affiliates shown below.

Recipients of Marketing Support Payments with Respect to the Columbia Funds from the Distributor and/or other Ameriprise Financial Affiliates

 

   

AIG Advisor Group

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc.*

   

AXA Advisors, LLC

   

Banc of America Investment Services, Inc.

   

Banc of America Securities LLC

   

Bank of America, N.A.

   

Bank of New York

   

Citibank, N.A.

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

   

Commonwealth Financial Network

   

Custodial Trust Company

   

Fidelity Brokerage Services, Inc.

   

Genworth Financial, Inc.

   

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

   

GunAllen Financial, Inc.

   

Harris Corporation

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Co.

   

J.J.B. Hilliard, W.L. Lyons, Inc.

   

J.P. Morgan Clearing Corp.

   

Liberty Life Insurance Co.

   

Lincoln Financial Advisors Corp.

   

Linsco/Private Ledger Corp.

   

Mellon Financial Markets, LLC

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

   

Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

   

National Financial Services LLC

   

Pershing LLC

   

Prudential Investment Management Services, LLC

   

Raymond James & Associates, Inc.

   

Raymond James Financial Services, Inc.

   

SEI Investments Inc.

   

State Street Global Markets, LLC

   

Transamerica Corporation

   

UBS Financial Services Inc.

   

US Bank National Association

   

Wachovia Securities LLC

   

Webster Investment Services, Inc.

   

Wells Fargo Corporate Trust Services

   

Wells Fargo Funds Management LLC

   

Wells Fargo Investments, LLC


 

* Ameriprise Financial affiliate

The Distributor and/or the Adviser may enter into similar arrangements with other financial intermediaries from time to time. Therefore, the preceding list is subject to change at any time without notice.

 

129


Table of Contents

 

Other Payments

From time to time, the Distributor, from its own resources, may provide additional compensation to certain financial intermediaries that sell or arrange for the sale of shares of the Funds to the extent not prohibited by laws or the rules of any self-regulatory agency, such as the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA). Such compensation provided by the Distributor may include financial assistance to financial intermediaries that enable the Distributor to participate in and/or present at financial intermediary-sponsored conferences or seminars, sales or training programs for invited registered representatives and other financial intermediary employees, financial intermediary entertainment and other financial intermediary-sponsored events, and travel expenses, including lodging incurred by registered representatives and other employees in connection with prospecting, retention and due diligence trips. The Distributor makes payments for entertainment events it deems appropriate, subject to the Distributor’s internal guidelines and applicable law. These payments may vary depending upon the nature of the event.

Your financial intermediary may charge you fees or commissions in addition to those disclosed in this SAI. You should consult with your financial intermediary and review carefully any disclosure your financial intermediary provides regarding its services and compensation. Depending on the financial arrangement in place at any particular time, a financial intermediary and its financial consultants may have a financial incentive for recommending a particular fund or a particular share class over other funds or share classes. See Investment Advisory and Other Services – Other Roles and Relationships of Ameriprise Financial and its Affiliates – Certain Conflicts of Interest for more information.

 

130


Table of Contents

 

CAPITAL STOCK AND OTHER SECURITIES

Description of the Trust’s Shares

The Funds offer shares in the classes shown in the table below. Subject to certain limited exceptions discussed in each Fund’s prospectuses, a Fund may no longer be accepting new investments from current shareholders or prospective investors. The Funds, however, may at any time and without notice, offer any of these classes to the general public for investment.

The Trust’s Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust (Declaration of Trust) permits it to issue an unlimited number of full and fractional shares of beneficial interest of each Fund, without par value, and to divide or combine the shares of any series into a greater or lesser number of shares of that Fund without thereby changing the proportionate beneficial interests in that Fund and to divide such shares into classes. Each share of a class of a Fund represents an equal proportional interest in that Fund with each other share in the same class and is entitled to such distributions out of the income earned on the assets belonging to that Fund as are declared in the discretion of the Board. However, different share classes of a Fund pay different distribution amounts because each share class has different expenses. Each time a distribution is made, the net asset value per share of the share class is reduced by the amount of the distribution.

Share Classes Offered by the Funds

 

Fund

  Class A
Shares
    Class  Ba
Shares
    Class C
Shares
    Class I
Shares
    Class R
Shares
    Class R4
Shares
    Class R5
Shares
    Class T
Shares
    Class W
Shares
    Class Y
Shares
    Class Z
Shares
    Other  

Balanced Fund

  ü        ü        ü          ü        ü c      ü c            ü       

Bond Fund

  ü        ü c      ü        ü              ü c      ü        ü        ü       

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

  ü        ü        ü                      ü       

Contrarian Core Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü c        ü        ü          ü       

Corporate Income Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü                ü          ü       

Dividend Income Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü            ü        ü          ü       

Emerging Markets Fund

  ü          ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

Energy and Natural Resources Fund

  ü        ü c      ü        ü        ü        ü c              ü       

High Yield Municipal Fund

  ü        ü        ü                      ü       

High Yield Opportunity Fund

  ü        ü        ü                      ü       

Intermediate Bond Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

International Bond Fund

  ü          ü        ü                    ü       

Large Cap Growth Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü c      ü c      ü        ü        ü        ü        ü b   

Mid Cap Growth Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü          ü c      ü        ü        ü        ü       

Pacific/Asia Fund

  ü          ü        ü                    ü       

Real Estate Equity Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü        ü c      ü c        ü          ü       

Select Large Cap Growth Fund

  ü          ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

Small Cap Core Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü              ü        ü          ü       

Small Cap Growth Fund I

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü                ü        ü       

Small Cap Value Fund I

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü                ü        ü       

Strategic Income Fund

  ü        ü        ü          ü        ü c      ü c        ü          ü       

Strategic Investor Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü        ü              ü        ü        ü       

U.S. Treasury Index Fund

  ü        ü        ü        ü                    ü       

Value and Restructuring Fund

  ü          ü        ü        ü              ü          ü       

 

a

Class B shares of the Funds are closed to new investments, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares. Additional Class B shares of the Funds will be issued only in connection with (i) reinvestment of dividends and/or capital gain distributions in Class B shares of the Funds by the Funds’ existing Class B shareholders and (ii) exchanges by shareholders invested in Class B shares of a Columbia Fund for Class B shares of the Funds. See the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds for details.

b

The Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund also offers Class E shares and Class F shares. See the prospectuses for Class E shares and Class F shares for details.

c

Classes have not yet commenced operations as of the date of this SAI.

 

131


Table of Contents

 

Restrictions on Holding or Disposing of Shares

There are no restrictions on the right of shareholders to retain or dispose of the Funds’ shares, other than the possible future termination of the Funds. The Funds may be terminated by reorganization into another mutual fund or by liquidation and distribution of their assets. Unless terminated by reorganization or liquidation, the Funds will continue indefinitely.

Liability

Under Massachusetts law, shareholders could, under certain circumstances, be held personally liable for the obligations of the Trust. However, the Trust’s Declaration of Trust disclaims any shareholder liability for acts or obligations of the Funds and the Trust and requires that notice of such disclaimer be given in each agreement, obligation, or instrument entered into or executed by a Fund or the Trustees. The Declaration of Trust provides for indemnification out of Fund property for all loss and expense of any shareholder held personally liable for the obligations of a Fund. Thus, the risk of a shareholder incurring financial loss on account of shareholder liability is limited to circumstances (which are considered remote) in which a Fund would be unable to meet its obligations and the disclaimer was inoperative.

The risk of a Fund incurring financial loss on account of another series of the Trust also is believed to be remote, because it would be limited to circumstances in which the disclaimer was inoperative and the other series of the Trust was unable to meet its obligations.

Dividend Rights

The shareholders of a Fund are entitled to receive any dividends or other distributions declared for the Fund. No shares have priority or preference over any other shares of a Fund with respect to distributions. Distributions will be made from the assets of a Fund, and will be paid pro rata to all shareholders of the Fund (or class) according to the number of shares of the Fund (or class) held by shareholders on the record date. The amount of income dividends per share may vary between separate share classes of a Fund based upon differences in the way that expenses are allocated between share classes pursuant to a multiple class plan.

Voting Rights and Shareholder Meetings

The Trust is not required to hold annual shareholder meetings, but special meetings may be called for certain purposes. The Trust voluntarily has undertaken to hold a shareholder meeting at which the Board would be elected at least every five years beginning in 2005. Each whole share (or fractional share) outstanding on the record date established in accordance with the Trust’s By-Laws shall be entitled to a number of votes on any matter on which it is entitled to vote equal to the net asset value of the share (or fractional share) in U.S. dollars determined at the close of business on the record date (for example, a share having a net asset value of $10.50 would be entitled to 10.5 votes).

The Trustees may fill any vacancies on the Board except that the Trustees may not fill a vacancy if, immediately after filling such vacancy, less than two-thirds of the Trustees then in office would have been elected to such office by the shareholders. In addition, at such times as less than a majority of the Trustees then in office have been elected to such office by the shareholders, the Trustees must call a meeting of shareholders. Trustees may be removed from office by a written consent signed by holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of the Trust or by a vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares at a meeting duly called for the purpose. Except as otherwise disclosed in a Fund’s prospectuses and this SAI, the Trustees shall continue to hold office and may appoint their successors.

At any shareholders’ meetings that may be held, shareholders of all series would vote together, irrespective of series, on the election of Trustees, but each series would vote separately from the others on other matters, such as changes in the investment policies of that series or the approval of the management agreement for that series.

 

132


Table of Contents

Shares of the Fund and any other series of the Trust that may be in existence from time to time generally vote together except when required by law to vote separately by Fund or by class.

Liquidation Rights

In the event of the liquidation or dissolution of the Trust or the Funds, shareholders of the Funds are entitled to receive the assets attributable to the relevant class of shares of the Funds that are available for distribution and to a distribution of any general assets not attributable to a particular investment portfolio that are available for distribution in such manner and on such basis as the Board may determine.

Preemptive Rights

There are no preemptive rights associated with Fund shares.

Conversion Rights

With the exception of Class B shares, which no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions from existing investors in Class B shares as described in the prospectuses for Class B shares of the Funds, shareholders have the right, which is subject to change by the Board, to convert or “exchange” shares of one class for another. Such right is outlined and subject to certain conditions set forth in each Fund’s prospectuses.

Redemptions

Each Fund’s dividend, distribution and redemption policies can be found in its prospectuses under the headings Buying, Selling and Exchanging Shares and Distributions and Taxes. However, the Board may suspend the right of shareholders to sell shares when permitted or required to do so by law or compel sales of shares in certain cases.

Sinking Fund Provisions

The Trust has no sinking fund provisions.

Calls or Assessment

All Fund shares are issued in uncertificated form only and when issued will be fully paid and non-assessable by the Trust.

 

133


Table of Contents

 

PURCHASE, REDEMPTION AND PRICING OF SHARES

Purchase and Redemption

An investor may buy, sell and exchange shares in the Funds utilizing the methods, and subject to the restrictions, described in the Funds’ prospectuses. The following information supplements information in the Funds’ prospectuses.

The Funds have authorized one or more broker/dealers to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. These broker/dealers are authorized to designate other intermediaries to accept buy and sell orders on the Funds’ behalf. The Funds will be deemed to have received a buy or sell order when an authorized broker/dealer, or, if applicable, a broker/dealer’s authorized designee, accepts the order. Customer orders will be priced at each Fund’s net asset value next computed after they are accepted by an authorized broker/dealer or the broker’s authorized designee.

The Trust also may make payment for sales in readily marketable securities or other property if it is appropriate to do so in light of the Trust’s responsibilities under the 1940 Act.

Under the 1940 Act, the Funds may suspend the right of redemption or postpone the date of payment for shares during any period when (i) trading on the NYSE is restricted by applicable rules and regulations of the SEC; (ii) the NYSE is closed for other than customary weekend and holiday closings; (iii) the SEC has by order permitted such suspension; (iv) an emergency exists as determined by the SEC. (The Funds may also suspend or postpone the recordation of the transfer of their shares upon the occurrence of any of the foregoing conditions).

The Trust has elected to be governed by Rule 18f–1 under the 1940 Act, as a result of which each Fund is obligated to redeem shares, subject to the exceptions listed above, with respect to any one shareholder during any 90-day period, solely in cash up to the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the net asset value of each Fund at the beginning of the period.

Tax-Advantaged Retirement Plans (Retirement Plans)

The Transfer Agent maintains prototype tax-qualified plans, including Pension and Profit-Sharing Plans, for individuals, corporations, employees and the self-employed. The minimum initial Retirement Plan investment is $1,000, applied at the plan level. BANA is the custodian/trustee and plan sponsor of the Columbia Management prototype plans offered through the Distributor. In general a $20 annual fee is charged. Participants in Retirement Plans not sponsored by BANA, not including IRAs, may be subject to an annual fee of $20 unless the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account with the Transfer Agent. Participants in BANA sponsored prototype plans (other than IRAs) who liquidate the total value of their account may also be charged a $20 close-out processing fee payable to the Transfer Agent. The close-out fee applies to plans opened after September 1, 1996. The fee is in addition to any applicable CDSC. The fee will not apply if the participant uses the proceeds to open a Columbia Management IRA Rollover account in any fund distributed by the Distributor, or if the Retirement Plan maintains an omnibus account. Consultation with a competent financial advisor regarding these Retirement Plans and consideration of the suitability of fund shares as an investment under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or otherwise is recommended.

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

134


Table of Contents

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares (other than Columbia Money Market Fund or Columbia Government Money Market Fund) within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

 

135


Table of Contents

 

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.
** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares, Class R5 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

136


Table of Contents

 

Anti-Money Laundering Compliance

The Funds are required to comply with various anti-money laundering laws and regulations. Consequently, the Funds may request additional required information from you to verify your identity. Your application will be rejected if it does not contain your name, social security number, date of birth and permanent street address. If at any time the Funds believe a shareholder may be involved in suspicious activity or if certain account information matches information on government lists of suspicious persons, the Funds may choose not to establish a new account or may be required to “freeze” a shareholder’s account. The Funds also may be required to provide a governmental agency with information about transactions that have occurred in a shareholder’s account or to transfer monies received to establish a new account, transfer an existing account or transfer the proceeds of an existing account to a governmental agency. In some circumstances, the law may not permit the Funds to inform the shareholder that it has taken the actions described above.

Offering Price

The share price of each Fund is based on each Fund’s net asset value per share, which is calculated separately for each class of shares as of the close of regular trading on the NYSE (which is usually 4:00 p.m. Eastern time unless the NYSE closes earlier) on each day the Funds are open for business, unless the Board determines otherwise.

The value of each Fund’s portfolio securities for which a market quotation is available is determined in accordance with the Trust’s valuation procedures. In general terms, the valuation procedures provide that domestic exchange traded securities (other than NASDAQ listed equity securities) generally will be valued at their last traded sale prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. If no sales of those securities are reported on a particular day on the principal exchange, the securities generally will be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices as reported on the principal exchange where those securities are traded. Securities traded on a foreign securities exchange will generally be valued at their last sale prices on the exchange where the securities are primarily traded, or in the absence of a reported sale on a particular day, at their bid prices (in the case of securities held long) or ask prices (in the case of securities held short) as reported by that exchange. Securities traded primarily on NASDAQ will generally be valued at the NASDAQ Official Closing Price (NOCP) (which is the last trade price at or before 4:00:02 p.m. (Eastern Time) adjusted up to NASDAQ’s best bid price if the last trade price is below such bid price or adjusted down to NASDAQ’s best ask price if the last trade price is above such ask price). If no NOCP is available, the security will generally be valued at the last sale price shown on NASDAQ prior to the calculation of the NAV of the Fund. If no sale price is shown on NASDAQ, the latest bid price will be used. If no sale price is shown and no latest bid price is available, the price will be deemed “stale” and the value will be determined in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

Securities not traded upon any exchange will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices based upon quotes furnished by the appropriate market makers. If quoted prices are unavailable or are believed to be inaccurate, market values will generally be determined based on quotes obtained from one or more broker(s) or dealer(s) or based on a price obtained from a reputable independent pricing service.

Financial futures will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price. Forward foreign currency contracts will generally be valued using market quotations from a widely used quotation system that reflects the current cost of covering or off-setting the contract. Exchange traded options will generally be valued at the latest reported sales price on their exchange. If there is no reported sale on the valuation date, the options will generally be valued at the mean between the latest bid and asked prices.

Over-the-counter derivatives will generally be valued at fair value in accordance with the Funds’ fair valuation procedures.

 

137


Table of Contents

 

Repurchase agreements will generally be valued at a price equal to the amount of the cash invested in the repurchase agreement at the time of valuation. The market value of the securities underlying a repurchase agreement will be determined in accordance with the procedures above, as appropriate, for the purpose of determining the adequacy of collateral.

Shares of open-end investment companies held in each Fund’s portfolio will generally be valued at the latest net asset value reported by the investment company.

Debt securities will generally be valued by a pricing service which may employ a matrix or other indications of value, including but not limited to broker quotes, to determine valuations for normal institutional size trading units. The matrix can take into account various factors including, without limitation, bids, yield spreads, and/or other market data and specific security characteristics (e.g., credit quality, maturity and coupon rate). Debt securities for which a pricing service does not furnish valuations and for which market quotations are readily available will generally be valued based on the mean of the latest bid prices obtained from one or more dealers. Debt securities with remaining maturities of 60 days or less will, absent unusual circumstances, be valued at amortized cost.

Securities for which market quotations are not readily available for any reason, including that the latest quotation is deemed unreliable or unreasonable, securities and other assets and liabilities are valued at “fair value” as determined in good faith by the Adviser’s valuation committee. In general, any one or more of the following factors may be taken into account in determining fair value: the fundamental analytical data relating to the security; the value of other financial instruments, including derivative securities, traded on other markets or among dealers; trading volumes on markets, exchanges, or among dealers; values of baskets of securities traded on other markets; changes in interest rates; observations from financial institutions; government (domestic or foreign) actions or pronouncements; other news events; information as to any transactions or offers with respect to the security; price and extent of public trading in similar securities of the issuer or comparable companies; nature and expected duration of the event, if any, giving rise to the valuation issue; pricing history of the security; the relative size of the position in the portfolio; and other relevant information.

With respect to securities traded on foreign markets, the following factors also may be relevant: the value of foreign securities traded on other foreign markets; ADR trading; closed-end fund trading; foreign currency exchange activity; and the trading of financial products that are tied to baskets of foreign securities, such as World Equity Benchmark Shares.

The Board has determined, and the valuation procedures provide, that in certain circumstances it may be necessary to use an alternative valuation method, such as in-kind redemptions with affiliated benefit plans where the Department of Labor requires that valuation to be done in accordance with Rule 17a-7 of the 1940 Act.

 

138


Table of Contents

 

TAXATION

The following information supplements and should be read in conjunction with the section in the Funds’ prospectuses entitled “Distributions and Taxes.” The prospectuses generally describe the U.S. federal income tax treatment of distributions by the Funds. This section of the SAI provides additional information concerning U.S. federal income taxes. It is based on the Code, applicable Treasury Regulations, judicial authority, and administrative rulings and practice, all as in effect as of the date of this SAI and all of which are subject to change, including changes with retroactive effect. Except as specifically set forth below, the following discussion does not address any state, local or foreign tax matters.

A shareholder’s tax treatment may vary depending upon his or her particular situation. This discussion applies only to shareholders holding Fund shares as capital assets within the meaning of the Code. Except as otherwise noted, it may not apply to certain types of shareholders who may be subject to special rules, such as insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, shareholders holding Fund shares through tax-advantaged accounts (such as 401(k) Plan Accounts or Individual Retirement Accounts), financial institutions, broker-dealers, entities that are not organized under the laws of the United States or a political subdivision thereof, persons who are neither citizens nor residents of the United States, shareholders holding Fund shares as part of a hedge, straddle, or conversion transaction, and shareholders who are subject to the U.S. federal alternative minimum tax.

The Trust has not requested and will not request an advance ruling from the IRS as to the U.S. federal income tax matters described below. The IRS could adopt positions contrary to those discussed below and such positions could be sustained. In addition, the following discussion and the discussions in the prospectuses applicable to each shareholder address only some of the U.S. federal income tax considerations generally affecting investments in the Funds. Prospective shareholders are urged to consult with their own tax advisors and financial planners regarding the U.S. federal tax consequences of an investment in a Fund, the application of state, local, or foreign laws, and the effect of any possible changes in applicable tax laws on their investment in the Funds.

Qualification as a Regulated Investment Company

It is intended that each Fund qualify as a “regulated investment company” under Subchapter M of Subtitle A, Chapter 1 of the Code. Each Fund will be treated as a separate entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Thus, the provisions of the Code applicable to regulated investment companies generally will apply separately to each Fund, even though each Fund is a series of the Trust. Furthermore, each Fund will separately determine its income, gains, losses, and expenses for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

In order to qualify for the special tax treatment accorded regulated investment companies and their shareholders, each Fund must, among other things, derive at least 90% of its gross income each taxable year generally from (i) dividends, interest, certain payments with respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities or foreign currencies, or other income attributable to its business of investing in such stock, securities or foreign currencies (including, but not limited to, gains from options, futures or forward contracts) and (ii) net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership, as defined below. In general, for purposes of this 90% gross income requirement, income derived from a partnership (other than a qualified publicly traded partnership) will be treated as qualifying income only to the extent such income is attributable to items of income of the partnership which would be qualifying income if realized directly by the regulated investment company. However, 100% of the net income derived from an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership (defined as a partnership (x) the interests in which are traded on an established securities market or readily tradable on a secondary market or the substantial equivalent thereof, (y) that derives at least 90% of its income from the passive income sources defined in Code Section 7704(d), and (z) that derives less than 90% of its income from the qualifying income described in clause (i) above) will be treated as qualifying income. Certain of a Fund’s investments in master limited partnerships (MLPs), if any, may

 

139


Table of Contents

qualify as interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, although in general the passive loss rules do not apply to a regulated investment company, such rules do apply to a regulated investment company with respect to items attributable to an interest in a qualified publicly traded partnership.

Each Fund must also diversify its holdings so that, at the end of each quarter of the Fund’s taxable year: (i) at least 50% of the fair market value of its total assets consists of (A) cash and cash items (including receivables), U.S. government securities and securities of other regulated investment companies, and (B) securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (A)) to the extent such securities do not exceed 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets and are not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (ii) not more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s total assets consists of the securities of any one issuer (other than those described in clause (i)(A)), the securities of two or more issuers the Fund controls and which are engaged in the same, similar, or related trades or businesses, or the securities of one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships. In addition, for purposes of meeting this diversification requirement, the term “outstanding voting securities of such issuer” includes the equity securities of a qualified publicly traded partnership and in the case of a Fund’s investments in loan participations, the Fund shall treat both the financial intermediary and the issuer of the underlying loan as an issuer. The qualifying income and diversification requirements described above may limit the extent to which a Fund can engage in certain derivative transactions, as well as the extent to which it can invest in MLPs.

In addition, each Fund generally must distribute to its shareholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income for the taxable year, which generally includes its ordinary income and the excess of any net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss, and at least 90% of its net tax-exempt interest income (if any) for the taxable year.

If a Fund qualifies as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment, it generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on any of the investment company taxable income and net capital gain (i.e., the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) it distributes to its shareholders (including Capital Gain Dividends, as defined below). Each Fund generally intends to distribute at least annually substantially all of its investment company taxable income (computed without regard to the dividends-paid deduction) and substantially all of its net capital gain. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to U.S. federal income taxation. Any investment company taxable income retained by a Fund will be subject to tax at regular corporate rates.

In addition, although each Fund generally intends to distribute all of its net capital gain, a Fund may determine to retain for investment all or a portion of its net capital gain. If a Fund retains any net capital gain, it will be subject to a tax at regular corporate rates on the amount retained, but may designate the retained amount as undistributed capital gains in a notice to its shareholders, who (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as long-term capital gain, their shares of such undistributed amount, and (ii) will be entitled to credit their proportionate shares of the tax paid by the Fund on such undistributed amount against their U.S. federal income tax liabilities, if any, and to claim refunds to the extent the credit exceeds such liabilities. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, the tax basis of shares owned by a shareholder of a Fund will be increased by an amount equal under current law to the difference between the amount of undistributed capital gains included in the shareholder’s gross income under clause (i) of the preceding sentence and the tax deemed paid by the shareholder under clause (ii) of the preceding sentence.

In determining its net capital gain for Capital Gain Dividend purposes, a regulated investment company generally must treat any net capital loss or any net long-term capital loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year. Treasury Regulations generally permit a regulated investment company, in determining its taxable income, to elect to treat all or part of any net capital loss, any net long-term capital loss or any foreign currency loss incurred after October 31 as if it had been incurred in the succeeding year.

 

140


Table of Contents

 

In order to comply with the distribution requirements described above applicable to regulated investment companies, a Fund generally must make the distributions in the same taxable year that it realizes the income and gain, although in certain circumstances, a Fund may make the distributions in the following taxable year in respect of income and gains from the prior taxable year. Shareholders generally are taxed on any distributions from a Fund in the year they are actually distributed. If a Fund declares a distribution to shareholders of record in October, November or December of one calendar year and pays the distribution by January 31 of the following calendar year, however, the Fund and its shareholders will be treated as if the Fund paid the distribution by December 31 of the earlier year.

If, for any taxable year, a Fund fails to qualify as a regulated investment company accorded special tax treatment under the Code, it will be taxed in the same manner as an ordinary corporation without any deduction for its distributions to shareholders, and all distributions from the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits (including any distributions of its net tax-exempt income and net long-term capital gains) to its shareholders will be taxable to shareholders as dividend income. In addition, the Fund could be required to recognize unrealized gains, pay substantial taxes and interest and make substantial distributions before requalifying as a regulated investment company.

Excise Tax

If a Fund fails to distribute by December 31 of each calendar year at least the sum of 98% of its ordinary income for that year (excluding capital gains and losses) and 98% of its capital gain net income (adjusted for net ordinary losses) for the 1-year period ending on October 31 of that year (or November 30 or December 31 of that year if the Fund is permitted to elect and so elects), and any of its ordinary income and capital gain net income from previous years that were not distributed during such years, the Fund will be subject to a nondeductible 4% excise tax on the undistributed amounts. For these purposes, a Fund will be treated as having distributed any amount on which it has been subject to corporate income tax in the taxable year ending within the calendar year. Each Fund generally intends to actually distribute or be deemed to have distributed substantially all of its ordinary income and capital gain net income, if any, by the end of each calendar year and, thus, expects not to be subject to the excise tax. However, no assurance can be given that a Fund will not be subject to the excise tax. Moreover, each Fund reserves the right to pay an excise tax rather than make an additional distribution when circumstances warrant (for example, if the amount of excise tax to be paid is deemed de minimis by a Fund).

Capital Loss Carryforwards

Subject to certain limitations, a Fund is permitted to carry forward a net capital loss from any year to offset its capital gains, if any, realized during the eight years following the year of the loss. A Fund’s capital loss carryforward is treated as a short-term capital loss in the year to which it is carried. If future capital gains are offset by carried forward capital losses, such future capital gains are not subject to fund-level U.S. federal income taxation, regardless of whether they are distributed to shareholders. Accordingly, the Funds do not expect to distribute any such offsetting capital gains. The Funds cannot carry back or carry forward any net operating losses.

Equalization Accounting

Each Fund may use the so-called “equalization method” of accounting to allocate a portion of its “accumulated earnings and profits,” which generally equals a Fund’s undistributed net investment income and realized capital gains, with certain adjustments, to redemption proceeds. This method permits a Fund to achieve more balanced distributions for both continuing and redeeming shareholders. Although using this method generally will not affect a Fund’s total returns, it may reduce the amount of income and gains that the Fund would otherwise distribute to continuing shareholders by reducing the effect of redemptions of Fund shares on Fund distributions to shareholders. The IRS has not sanctioned the particular equalization method used by the Funds, and thus a Fund’s use of this method may be subject to IRS scrutiny.

 

141


Table of Contents

 

Investment through Master Portfolios

Some Funds seek to continue to qualify as regulated investment companies by investing their assets through one or more Master Portfolios. Each Master Portfolio will be treated as a non-publicly traded partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes rather than as a regulated investment company or a corporation under the Code. Under the rules applicable to a non-publicly traded partnership, a proportionate share of any interest, dividends, gains and losses of a Master Portfolio will be deemed to have been realized (i.e., “passed through”) to its investors, including the corresponding Fund, regardless of whether any amounts are actually distributed by the Master Portfolio. Each investor in a Master Portfolio will be taxed on such share, as determined in accordance with the governing instruments of the particular Master Portfolio, the Code and Treasury Regulations, in determining such investor’s U.S. federal income tax liability. Therefore, to the extent a Master Portfolio were to accrue but not distribute any income or gains, the corresponding Fund would be deemed to have realized its proportionate share of such income or gains without receipt of any corresponding distribution. However, each of the Master Portfolios will seek to minimize recognition by its investors (such as a corresponding Fund) of income and gains without a corresponding distribution. Furthermore, each Master Portfolio intends to manage its assets, income and distributions in such a way that an investor in a Master Portfolio will be able to continue to qualify as a regulated investment company by investing its assets through the Master Portfolio.

Taxation of Fund Investments

In general, realized gains or losses on the sale of securities held by a Fund will be treated as capital gains or losses, and long-term capital gains or losses if the Fund has held or is deemed to have held the securities for more than one year at the time of disposition.

If a Fund purchases a debt obligation with original issue discount (OID) (generally a debt obligation with an issue price less than its stated principal amount, such as a zero-coupon bond), the Fund may be required to annually include in its income a portion of the OID as ordinary income, even though the Fund will not receive cash payments for such discount until maturity or disposition of the obligation. Inflation-protected bonds generally can be expected to produce OID income as their principal amounts are adjusted upward for inflation. In general, gains recognized on the disposition of (or the receipt of any partial payment of principal on) a debt obligation (including a municipal obligation) purchased by a Fund at a market discount, generally at a price less than its principal amount, will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the portion of market discount which accrued, but was not previously recognized pursuant to an available election, during the term that the Fund held the debt obligation. A Fund generally will be required to make distributions to shareholders representing the OID or market discount (if an election is made by the Fund to accrue market discount over the holding period of the applicable debt obligation) on debt securities that is currently includible in income, even though the cash representing such income may not have been received by the Fund. Cash to pay such distributions may be obtained from borrowing or from sales proceeds of securities held by a Fund which the Fund otherwise might have continued to hold; obtaining such cash might be disadvantageous for the Fund.

In addition, payment-in-kind securities similarly will give rise to income which is required to be distributed and is taxable even though a Fund receives no cash interest payment on the security during the year. A portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations (such as high-yield corporate debt securities) may not (and interest paid on debt obligations owned by a Fund that are considered for tax purposes to be payable in the equity of the issuer or a related party will not) be deductible to the issuer, possibly affecting the cash flow of the issuer.

If a Fund invests in debt obligations that are in the lowest rating categories or are unrated, including debt obligations of issuers not currently paying interest or who are in default, special tax issues may exist for the Fund. Tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as whether a Fund should recognize market discount on a debt obligation and, if so, the amount of market discount the Fund should recognize, when a Fund may cease to accrue interest, OID or market discount, when and to what extent deductions may be taken for bad debts or

 

142


Table of Contents

worthless securities and how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income. These and other related issues will be addressed by a Fund when, as and if it invests in such securities, in order to seek to ensure that it distributes sufficient income to preserve its status as a regulated investment company and does not become subject to U.S. federal income or excise tax.

If an option granted by a Fund is sold, lapses or is otherwise terminated through a closing transaction, such as a repurchase by the Fund of the option from its holder, the Fund generally will realize a short-term capital gain or loss, depending on whether the premium income is greater or less than the amount paid by the Fund in the closing transaction. Some capital losses realized by a Fund in the sale, exchange, exercise or other disposition of an option may be deferred if they result from a position that is part of a “straddle,” discussed below. If securities are sold by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a covered call option granted by it, the Fund generally will add the premium received to the sale price of the securities delivered in determining the amount of gain or loss on the sale. If securities are purchased by a Fund pursuant to the exercise of a put option written by it, the Fund generally will subtract the premium received from its cost basis in the securities purchased.

Some regulated futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity, listed options that may be used by a Fund will be deemed “Section 1256 contracts.” A Fund will be required to “mark to market” any such contracts held at the end of the taxable year by treating them as if they had been sold on the last day of that year at market value. Sixty percent of any net gain or loss realized on all dispositions of Section 1256 contracts, including deemed dispositions under the “mark-to-market” rule, generally will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss, and the remaining 40% will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss, although certain foreign currency gains and losses from such contracts may be treated as ordinary income or loss as described below. These provisions may require a Fund to recognize income or gains without a concurrent receipt of cash. Transactions that qualify as designated hedges are exempt from the mark-to-market rule and the “60%/40%” rule and may require the Fund to defer the recognition of losses on certain futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and non-equity options.

Foreign exchange gains and losses realized by a Fund in connection with certain transactions involving foreign currency-denominated debt securities, certain options, futures contracts, forward contracts and similar instruments relating to foreign currency, foreign currencies, or payables or receivables denominated in a foreign currency are subject to Section 988 of the Code, which generally causes such gains and losses to be treated as ordinary income or loss and may affect the amount and timing of recognition of the Fund’s income. Under future Treasury Regulations, any such transactions that are not directly related to a Fund’s investments in stock or securities (or its options contracts or futures contracts with respect to stock or securities) may have to be limited in order to enable the Fund to satisfy the 90% qualifying income test described above. If the net foreign exchange loss exceeds a Fund’s net investment company taxable income (computed without regard to such loss) for a taxable year, the resulting ordinary loss for such year will not be available as a carryforward and thus cannot be deducted by the Fund or its shareholders in future years.

Offsetting positions held by a Fund involving certain derivative instruments, such as forward, futures and options contracts, may be considered, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to constitute “straddles.” “Straddles” are defined to include “offsetting positions” in actively traded personal property. The tax treatment of “straddles” is governed by Section 1092 of the Code which, in certain circumstances, overrides or modifies the provisions of Section 1256. If a Fund is treated as entering into a “straddle” and at least one (but not all) of the Fund’s positions in derivative contracts comprising a part of such straddle is governed by Section 1256 of the Code, described above, then such straddle could be characterized as a “mixed straddle.” A Fund may make one or more elections with respect to “mixed straddles.” Depending upon which election is made, if any, the results with respect to a Fund may differ. Generally, to the extent the straddle rules apply to positions established by a Fund, losses realized by the Fund may be deferred to the extent of unrealized gain in any offsetting positions. Moreover, as a result of the straddle rules, short-term capital loss on straddle positions may be recharacterized as long-term capital loss, and long-term capital gain may be characterized as short-term capital gain. In addition, the existence of a straddle may affect the holding period of the offsetting positions. As a result, the straddle rules

 

143


Table of Contents

could cause distributions that would otherwise constitute “qualified dividend income” or qualify for the dividends-received deduction to fail to satisfy the applicable holding period requirements (as described below). Furthermore, the Fund may be required to capitalize, rather than deduct currently, any interest expense and carrying charges applicable to a position that is part of a straddle, including any interest on indebtedness incurred or continued to purchase or carry any positions that are part of a straddle. The application of the straddle rules to certain offsetting Fund positions can therefore affect the amount, timing, and character of distributions to shareholders, and may result in significant differences from the amount, timing and character of distributions that would have been made by the Fund if it had not entered into offsetting positions in respect of certain of its portfolio securities.

If a Fund enters into a “constructive sale” of any appreciated financial position in stock, a partnership interest, or certain debt instruments, the Fund will be treated as if it had sold and immediately repurchased the property and must recognize gain (but not loss) with respect to that position. A constructive sale of an appreciated financial position occurs when a Fund enters into certain offsetting transactions with respect to the same or substantially identical property, including, but not limited to: (i) a short sale; (ii) an offsetting notional principal contract; (iii) a futures or forward contract; or (iv) other transactions identified in future Treasury Regulations. The character of the gain from constructive sales will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the appreciated financial position. Losses realized from a sale of a position that was previously the subject of a constructive sale will be recognized when the position is subsequently disposed of. The character of such losses will depend upon a Fund’s holding period in the position beginning with the date the constructive sale was deemed to have occurred and the application of various loss deferral provisions in the Code. Constructive sale treatment does not apply to certain closed transactions, including if such a transaction is closed on or before the 30th day after the close of the Fund’s taxable year and the Fund holds the appreciated financial position unhedged throughout the 60-day period beginning with the day such transaction was closed.

The amount of long-term capital gain a Fund may recognize from certain derivative transactions with respect to interests in certain pass-through entities is limited under the Code’s constructive ownership rules. The amount of long-term capital gain is limited to the amount of such gain the Fund would have had if the Fund directly invested in the pass-through entity during the term of the derivative contract. Any gain in excess of this amount is treated as ordinary income. An interest charge is imposed on the amount of gain that is treated as ordinary income.

If a Fund makes a distribution of income received by the Fund in lieu of dividends (a “substitute payment”) with respect to securities on loan pursuant to a securities lending transaction, such income will not constitute qualified dividend income to individual shareholders and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction for corporate shareholders. Similar consequences may apply to repurchase and other derivative transactions. Similarly, to the extent that a Fund makes distributions of income received by such Fund in lieu of tax-exempt interest with respect to securities on loan, such distributions will not constitute exempt-interest dividends (defined below) to shareholders.

In addition, a Fund’s transactions in securities and certain types of derivatives (e.g., options, futures contracts, forward contracts and swap agreements) may be subject to other special tax rules, such as the wash-sale rules or the short-sale rules, the effect of which may be to accelerate income to the Fund, defer losses to the Fund, cause adjustments in the holding periods of the Fund’s securities, convert long-term capital gains into short-term capital gains, and/or convert short-term capital losses into long-term capital losses. These rules could therefore affect the amount, timing and character of distributions to shareholders.

Certain of a Fund’s investments in derivative instruments and foreign currency-denominated instruments, as well as any of its foreign currency transactions and hedging activities, are likely to produce a difference between its book income and its taxable income. If a Fund’s book income exceeds the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the distribution (if any) of such excess generally will be treated as (i) a dividend to the extent of the Fund’s remaining earnings and profits (including earnings and profits arising from tax-exempt

 

144


Table of Contents

income), (ii) thereafter, as a return of capital to the extent of the recipient’s basis in its shares, and (iii) thereafter, as gain from the sale or exchange of a capital asset. If a Fund’s book income is less than the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the Fund could be required to make distributions exceeding book income to qualify as a regulated investment company that is accorded special tax treatment.

Rules governing the U.S. federal income tax aspects of derivatives, including swap agreements, are in a developing stage and are not entirely clear in certain respects. Accordingly, while each Fund intends to account for such transactions in a manner it deems to be appropriate, an adverse determination or future guidance by the IRS with respect to these rules (which determination or guidance could be retroactive) may affect whether a Fund has made sufficient distributions, and otherwise satisfied the relevant requirements to maintain its qualification as a regulated investment company and avoid fund-level tax. Certain requirements that must be met under the Code in order for a Fund to qualify as a regulated investment company may limit the extent to which a Fund will be able to engage in certain derivatives transactions.

Any investment by a Fund in equity securities of a REIT may result in the Fund’s receipt of cash in excess of the REIT’s earnings; if the Fund distributes these amounts, these distributions could constitute a return of capital to Fund shareholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Investments in equity securities of a REIT or another regulated investment company also may require a Fund to accrue and distribute income not yet received. To generate sufficient cash to make the requisite distributions, the Fund may be required to sell securities in its portfolio (including when it is not advantageous to do so) that it otherwise would have continued to hold. Dividends received by the Fund from a REIT generally will not constitute qualified dividend income and will not qualify for the dividends-received deduction.

A Fund may invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in taxable mortgage pools (TMPs). Under an IRS notice, and Treasury Regulations that have yet to be issued but may apply retroactively, a portion of a Fund’s income (including income allocated to the Fund from a REIT, a regulated investment company or other pass-through entity) that is attributable to a residual interest in a REMIC or an equity interest in a TMP (referred to in the Code as an “excess inclusion”) will be subject to U.S. federal income tax in all events. This notice also provides, and the regulations are expected to provide, that excess inclusion income of a regulated investment company, such as a Fund, will be allocated to shareholders of the regulated investment company in proportion to the dividends received by such shareholders, with the same consequences as if the shareholders held the related interest directly. As a result, the Fund may not be a suitable investment for certain tax-exempt shareholders, as noted under “Tax-Exempt Shareholders” below.

In general, excess inclusion income allocated to shareholders (i) cannot be offset by net operating losses (subject to a limited exception for certain thrift institutions), (ii) will constitute unrelated business taxable income (UBTI) to entities (including a qualified pension plan, an individual retirement account, a 401(k) plan, a Keogh plan or certain other tax-exempt entities) subject to tax on UBTI, thereby potentially requiring such an entity that is allocated excess inclusion income, and otherwise might not be required to file a tax return, to file a tax return and pay tax on such income, and (iii) in the case of a foreign shareholder, will not qualify for any reduction in U.S. federal withholding tax.

Some amounts received by a Fund from its investments in MLPs will likely be treated as returns of capital because of accelerated deductions available with respect to the activities of MLPs. On the disposition of an investment in such an MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of economic gain from that asset (or if a Fund does not dispose of the MLP, the Fund will likely realize taxable income in excess of cash flow received by the Fund from the MLP in a later period), and the Fund must take such income into account in determining whether the Fund has satisfied its regulated investment company distribution requirements. The Fund may have to borrow or liquidate securities to satisfy its distribution requirements and meet its redemption requests, even though investment considerations might otherwise make it undesirable for the Fund to borrow money or sell securities at the time. In addition, distributions attributable to gain from the sale of MLPs that are characterized as ordinary income under the Code’s recapture provisions will be taxable to Fund shareholders as ordinary income.

 

145


Table of Contents

 

“Passive foreign investment companies” (PFICs) are generally defined as foreign corporations where at least 75% of their gross income for their taxable year is income from passive sources (such as certain interest, dividends, rents and royalties, or capital gains) or at least 50% of their assets on average produce such passive income. If a Fund acquires any equity interest in a PFIC, the Fund could be subject to U.S. federal income tax and interest charges on “excess distributions” received from the PFIC or on gain from the sale of such equity interest in the PFIC, even if all income or gain actually received by the Fund is timely distributed to its shareholders. Excess distributions and gain from the sale of interests in PFICs may be characterized as ordinary income even though, absent the application of PFIC rules, these amounts may otherwise have been classified as capital gain.

A Fund will not be permitted to pass through to its shareholders any credit or deduction for these special taxes and interest charges incurred with respect to a PFIC. Elections may be available that would ameliorate these adverse tax consequences, but such elections would require a Fund to include its share of the PFIC’s income and net capital gains annually, regardless of whether it receives any distribution from the PFIC (in the case of a “QEF election”), or to mark the gains (and to a limited extent losses) in its interests in the PFIC “to the market” as though the Fund had sold and repurchased such interests on the last day of the Fund’s taxable year, treating such gains and losses as ordinary income and loss (in the case of a “mark-to-market election”). The QEF and mark-to-market elections may require a Fund to recognize taxable income or gain without the concurrent receipt of cash and increase the amount required to be distributed by the Fund to avoid taxation. Making either of these elections therefore may require a Fund to liquidate other investments prematurely to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above, which also may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return. Each Fund may attempt to limit and/or manage its holdings in PFICs to minimize tax liability and/or maximize returns from these investments but there can be no assurance that it will be able to do so. Moreover, because it is not always possible to identify a foreign corporation as a PFIC in advance of acquiring shares in the corporation, a Fund may incur the tax and interest charges described above in some instances. Dividends paid by PFICs will not be eligible to be treated as qualified dividend income, as defined below.

In addition to the investments described above, prospective shareholders should be aware that other investments made by a Fund may involve complex tax rules that may result in income or gain recognition by the Fund without corresponding current cash receipts. Although each Fund seeks to avoid significant noncash income, such noncash income could be recognized by a Fund, in which case the Fund may distribute cash derived from other sources in order to meet the minimum distribution requirements described above. In this regard, a Fund could be required at times to liquidate investments prematurely in order to satisfy its minimum distribution requirements, which may accelerate the recognition of gain and adversely affect the Fund’s total return.

Taxation of Distributions

Except for exempt-interest dividends (defined below) paid by a Fund, distributions paid out of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits, whether paid in cash or reinvested in the Fund, generally are deemed to be taxable distributions and must be reported by each shareholder who is required to file a U.S. federal income tax return. Dividends and distributions on a Fund’s shares are generally subject to U.S. federal income tax as described herein to the extent they do not exceed the Fund’s realized income and gains, even though such dividends and distributions may economically represent a return of a particular shareholder’s investment. Such distributions are likely to occur in respect of shares purchased at a time when the Fund’s net asset value reflects either unrealized gains, or realized but undistributed income or gains. Such realized income and gains may be required to be distributed even when the Fund’s net asset value also reflects unrealized losses. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, a Fund’s earnings and profits, described above, are determined at the end of the Fund’s taxable year and are allocated pro rata to distributions paid over the entire year. Distributions in excess of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits will first be treated as a return of capital up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares and then as capital gain. A return of capital is not taxable, but

 

146


Table of Contents

it reduces a shareholder’s tax basis in his or her Fund shares, thus reducing any loss or increasing any gain on a subsequent taxable disposition by the shareholder of his or her shares. A Fund may make distributions in excess of its earnings and profits to a limited extent, from time to time.

For U.S. federal income tax purposes, distributions of investment income (except for exempt-interest dividends, defined below) are generally taxable as ordinary income, and distributions of gains from the sale of investments that a Fund owned (or is deemed to have owned) for one year or less will be taxable as ordinary income. Distributions properly designated by a Fund as capital gain dividends (“Capital Gain Dividends”) will be taxable to shareholders as long-term capital gain (to the extent such distributions do not exceed the Fund’s actual net long-term capital gain for the taxable year), regardless of how long a shareholder has held Fund shares, and do not qualify as dividends for purposes of the dividends-received deduction or as qualified dividend income (defined below). Each Fund will designate Capital Gain Dividends, if any, in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year.

Some states will not tax distributions made to individual shareholders that are attributable to interest a Fund earns on direct obligations of the U.S. government if the Fund meets the state’s minimum investment or reporting requirements, if any. Investments in GNMA or FNMA securities, bankers’ acceptances, commercial paper, and repurchase agreements collateralized by U.S. government securities generally do not qualify for tax-free treatment. This exemption may not apply to corporate shareholders.

Sales and Exchanges of Fund Shares

If a shareholder sells or exchanges his or her Fund shares, he or she generally will realize a taxable capital gain or loss on the difference between the amount received for the shares (or deemed received in the case of an exchange) and his or her tax basis in the shares. This gain or loss will be long-term capital gain or loss if he or she has held (or is deemed to have held) such Fund shares for more than one year at the time of the sale or exchange, and short-term capital gain or loss otherwise.

If a shareholder sells or exchanges Fund shares within 90 days of having acquired such shares and if, as a result of having initially acquired those shares, he or she subsequently pays a reduced sales charge on a new purchase of shares of the Fund or a different regulated investment company, the sales charge previously incurred in acquiring the Fund’s shares generally shall not be taken into account (to the extent the previous sales charges do not exceed the reduction in sales charges on the new purchase) for the purpose of determining the amount of gain or loss on the disposition, but generally will be treated as having been incurred in the new purchase. Also, if a shareholder realizes a loss on a disposition of Fund shares, the loss will be disallowed under “wash sale” rules to the extent that he or she purchases substantially identical shares within the 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the disposition. Any disallowed loss generally will be reflected in an adjustment to the tax basis of the purchased shares.

If a shareholder receives a Capital Gain Dividend or is deemed to receive a distribution of long-term capital gain with respect to any Fund share and such Fund share is held or treated as held for six months or less, then (unless otherwise disallowed) any loss on the sale or exchange of that Fund share will be treated as a long-term capital loss to the extent of the Capital Gain Dividend or deemed long-term capital gain distribution. If shares of a Fund are sold at a loss after being held for six months or less, the loss will be disallowed to the extent of any exempt-interest dividends (defined below) received on those shares.

Foreign Taxes

Amounts realized by a Fund from sources within foreign countries may be subject to withholding and other taxes imposed by such countries. Tax conventions between certain countries and the United States may reduce or eliminate such taxes. If more than 50% of the value of a Fund’s total assets at the close of its taxable year consists of securities of foreign corporations, the Fund will be eligible to file an annual election with the IRS

 

147


Table of Contents

pursuant to which the Fund may pass through to its shareholders on a pro rata basis foreign income and similar taxes paid by the Fund with respect to foreign securities that the Fund has held for at least the minimum holding periods specified in the Code and such taxes may be claimed, subject to certain limitations, either as a tax credit or deduction by the shareholders. A Fund that invests primarily or exclusively in other regulated investment companies would not be eligible for this election, even if the underlying regulated investment companies were eligible and did make the election.

Certain Funds may qualify for and make the election; however, even if a Fund qualifies for the election for any year, it may determine not to make the election for such year. If a Fund does not so qualify or qualifies but does not so elect, then shareholders will not be entitled to claim a credit or deduction with respect to foreign taxes paid by or withheld from payments to the Fund. A Fund will notify its shareholders within 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year if it has elected for the foreign taxes paid by it to “pass through” for that year.

In general, if a Fund makes the election, the Fund itself will not be permitted to claim a credit or deduction for foreign taxes paid in that year, and the Fund’s dividends-paid deduction will be increased by the amount of foreign taxes paid that year. Fund shareholders generally shall include their proportionate share of the foreign taxes paid by the Fund in their gross income and treat that amount as paid by them for the purpose of the foreign tax credit or deduction, provided that any applicable holding period and other requirements have been met. If a shareholder claims a credit for foreign taxes paid, in general, the credit will be subject to certain limits. A deduction for foreign taxes paid may be claimed only by shareholders that itemize their deductions.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Rates

As of the date of this SAI, the maximum stated U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to individuals generally is 35% for ordinary income and 15% for net long-term capital gain. Long-term capital gain rates applicable to individuals have been temporarily reduced – in general, to 15% with lower rates applying to taxpayers in the 10% and 15% rate brackets – for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

For taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011, U.S. federal income tax law also provides for a maximum individual U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to “qualified dividend income” equal to the highest net long-term capital gain rate, which, as described above, generally is 15%. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this provision for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2011. In general, “qualified dividend income” is income attributable to dividends received by a Fund from certain domestic and foreign corporations, as long as certain holding period and other requirements are met by the Fund with respect to the dividend-paying corporation’s stock and by the shareholders with respect to the Fund’s shares. If 95% or more of a Fund’s gross income (excluding net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) constitutes qualified dividend income, all of its distributions (other than Capital Gain Dividends) will be generally treated as qualified dividend income in the hands of individual shareholders, as long as they have owned their Fund shares for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the Fund’s ex-dividend date (or, in the case of certain preferred stock, 91 days during the 181-day period beginning 90 days before such date) and meet certain other requirements specified in the Code. In general, if less than 95% of a Fund’s income is attributable to qualified dividend income, then only the portion of the Fund’s distributions that is attributable to qualified dividend income and designated as such in a timely manner will be so treated in the hands of individual shareholders who meet the aforementioned holding period requirements. The rules regarding the qualification of Fund distributions as qualified dividend income are complex, including the holding period requirements. Individual Fund shareholders therefore are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners. Fixed income funds typically do not distribute significant amounts of qualified dividend income.

The maximum stated corporate U.S. federal income tax rate applicable to ordinary income and net capital gain is 35%. Actual marginal tax rates may be higher for some shareholders, for example, through reductions in deductions. Naturally, the amount of tax payable by any taxpayer will be affected by a combination of tax laws

 

148


Table of Contents

covering, for example, deductions, credits, deferrals, exemptions, sources of income and other matters. U.S. federal income tax rates are set to increase in future years under various “sunset” provisions of U.S. federal income tax laws.

Backup Withholding

Each Fund generally is required to withhold, and remit to the U.S. Treasury, subject to certain exemptions, an amount equal to 28% of all distributions and redemption proceeds (including proceeds from exchanges and redemptions in-kind) paid or credited to a Fund shareholder if (1) the shareholder fails to furnish the Fund with a correct “taxpayer identification number” (TIN) or has not certified to the Fund that withholding does not apply or (2) the IRS notifies the Fund that the shareholder’s TIN is incorrect or the shareholder is otherwise subject to backup withholding. These backup withholding rules may also apply to distributions that are properly designated as exempt-interest dividends (defined below). This backup withholding is not an additional tax imposed on the shareholder. The shareholder may apply amounts required to be withheld as a credit against his or her future U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS. If a shareholder fails to furnish a valid TIN upon request, the shareholder can also be subject to IRS penalties. Unless Congress enacts legislation providing otherwise, the rate of backup withholding is set to increase to 31% for amounts distributed or paid after December 31, 2010.

Tax-Deferred Plans

The shares of a Fund may be available for a variety of tax-deferred retirement and other tax-advantaged plans and accounts. Prospective investors should contact their tax advisors and financial planners regarding the tax consequences to them of holding Fund shares through such plans and/or accounts.

Corporate Shareholders

Subject to limitations and other rules, a corporate shareholder of a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction on Fund distributions attributable to dividends received by the Fund from domestic corporations, which, if received directly by the corporate shareholder, would qualify for such a deduction. For eligible corporate shareholders, the dividends-received deduction may be subject to certain reductions, and a distribution by a Fund attributable to dividends of a domestic corporation will be eligible for the deduction only if certain holding period and other requirements are met. These requirements are complex; therefore, corporate shareholders of the Funds are urged to consult their own tax advisors and financial planners.

As discussed above, a portion of the interest paid or accrued on certain high-yield discount obligations that a Fund may own may not be deductible to the issuer. If a portion of the interest paid or accrued on these obligations is not deductible, that portion will be treated as a dividend. In such cases, if the issuer of the obligation is a domestic corporation, dividend payments by a Fund may be eligible for the dividends-received deduction to the extent of the dividend portion of such interest.

Foreign Shareholders

For purposes of this discussion, “foreign shareholders” generally include: (i) nonresident alien individuals, (ii) foreign trusts (i.e., a trust other than a trust with respect to which a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over administration of that trust and one or more U.S. persons have authority to control substantial decisions of that trust), (iii) foreign estates (i.e., the income of which is not subject to U.S. tax regardless of source), and (iv) foreign corporations.

Generally, unless an exception applies, dividend distributions made to foreign shareholders other than Capital Gain Dividends and exempt-interest dividends (defined below) will be subject to non-refundable U.S. federal income tax withholding at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income

 

149


Table of Contents

tax treaty) even if they are funded by income or gains (such as portfolio interest, short-term capital gains, or foreign-source dividend and interest income) that, if paid to a foreign person directly, would not be subject to withholding. However, generally, for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions made to foreign shareholders and properly designated by a Fund as “interest-related dividends” were exempt from U.S. federal income tax withholding. The exemption for interest-related dividends did not apply to any distribution to a foreign shareholder (i) to the extent that the dividend was attributable to certain interest on an obligation if the foreign shareholder was the issuer or was a 10% shareholder of the issuer, (ii) that was within certain foreign countries that had inadequate information exchange with the United States, or (iii) to the extent the dividend was attributable to interest paid by a person that was a related person of the foreign shareholder and the foreign shareholder was a controlled foreign corporation. Interest-related dividends were generally attributable to the Fund’s net U.S.-source interest income of types similar to those not subject to U.S. federal income tax if earned directly by an individual foreign shareholder. In order to qualify as an interest-related dividend, the Fund was required to designate a distribution as such in a written notice mailed to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a distribution described above is “effectively connected” with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, is attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the recipient foreign shareholder, U.S. federal income tax withholding will not apply. Instead, the distribution will be subject to the tax, reporting and withholding requirements generally applicable to U.S. persons, and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the recipient foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation.

In general, a foreign shareholder’s capital gains realized on the disposition of Fund shares and distributions properly designated as Capital Gain Dividends are not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax, unless: (i) such gains or distributions are effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business (or, if an income tax treaty applies, are attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment) of the foreign shareholder; (ii) in the case of an individual foreign shareholder, the shareholder is present in the U.S. for a period or periods aggregating 183 days or more during the year of the disposition of Fund shares or the receipt of Capital Gain Dividends and certain other conditions are met; or (iii) the Fund shares on which the foreign shareholder realized gain constitute U.S. real property interests (USRPIs, defined below) or, in certain cases, the distributions are attributable to gain from the sale or exchange of a USRPI, as discussed below. If the requirements of clause (i) are met, the tax, reporting and withholding requirements applicable to U.S. persons generally will apply to the foreign shareholder and an additional branch profits tax may apply if the foreign shareholder is a foreign corporation. If the requirements of clause (i) are not met, but the requirements of clause (ii) are met, such gains and distributions will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be provided under an applicable income tax treaty). Please see below for a discussion of the tax implications to foreign shareholders in the event that clause (iii) applies. With respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning before January 1, 2010, distributions to a foreign shareholder attributable to a Fund’s net short-term capital gain in excess of its net long-term capital loss and designated as such by the Fund in a written notice mailed by the Fund to its shareholders not later than 60 days after the close of the Fund’s taxable year (“short-term capital gain dividends”) were generally not subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax unless clause (i), (ii) or (iii) above applied to such distribution.

It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend the exemptions from withholding for interest-related dividends and short-term capital gain dividends with respect to taxable years of a Fund beginning on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Even if permitted to do so, each Fund provides no assurance that it would designate any distributions as interest-related dividends or short-term capital gain dividends.

In the case of shares held through an intermediary, even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment, no assurance can be made that the intermediary will respect such a designation, and an intermediary may withhold even if a Fund makes a designation with respect to a payment. Foreign shareholders should contact their intermediaries regarding the application of these rules to their accounts.

Special rules apply to distributions to foreign shareholders from a Fund if it is either a “U.S. real property holding corporation” (USRPHC) or would be a USRPHC but for the operation of certain exceptions from USRPI

 

150


Table of Contents

treatment for interests in domestically controlled REITs or regulated investment companies and not-greater- than-5% interests in publicly traded classes of stock in REITs or regulated investment companies. Additionally, special rules apply to the sale of shares in a Fund if it is a USRPHC. Generally, a USRPHC is a domestic corporation that holds USRPIs – defined generally as any interest in U.S. real property or any equity interest in a USRPHC – the fair market value of which equals or exceeds 50% of the sum of the fair market values of the corporation’s USRPIs, interests in real property located outside the United States and other assets. If a Fund holds (directly or indirectly) significant interests in REITs, it may be a USRPHC.

If a Fund is a USRPHC or would be a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, amounts the Fund receives from REITs derived from gains realized from USRPIs generally will retain their character as such in the hands of the Fund’s foreign shareholders. In the hands of a foreign shareholder that holds (or has held in the prior 12 months) more than a 5% interest in any class of the Fund, such amounts generally will be treated as gains “effectively connected” with the conduct of a “U.S. trade or business,” and subject to tax at graduated rates. Moreover, such shareholder generally will be required to file a U.S. income tax return for the year recognized, and the Fund must withhold 35% of the amount of such distribution. Otherwise, in the case of all other foreign shareholders (i.e., those whose interest in any class of the Fund did not exceed 5% at any time during the prior 12 months), such amounts generally will be treated as ordinary income (regardless of any designation by the Fund that such distribution is a Capital Gain Dividend), and the Fund must withhold 30% (or a lower applicable treaty rate) of the amount of the distribution paid to such shareholders. If a Fund is subject to the rules of this paragraph, its foreign shareholders may also be subject to “wash sale” rules to prevent the avoidance of the foregoing tax-filing and payment obligations through the sale and repurchase of Fund shares. Prior to January 1, 2010, if a Fund was a USRPHC or would have been a USRPHC but for certain of the above-mentioned exceptions, similar rules generally also applied to any non-REIT USRPI gains recognized by the Fund directly or indirectly through certain lower-tier regulated investment companies. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend such application for distributions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be.

In addition, if a Fund is a USRPHC, it generally must withhold 10% of the amount realized in redemption by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder, and that shareholder must file a U.S. income tax return for the year of the disposition of the USRPI and pay any additional tax due on the gain. Prior to January 1, 2010, such withholding generally was not required with respect to amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund if it was a domestically controlled USRPHC, or, in certain limited cases, if the Fund (whether or not domestically controlled) held substantial investments in regulated investment companies that were domestically controlled USRPHCs. It is currently unclear whether Congress will extend this exemption from withholding for redemptions made on or after January 1, 2010 and what the terms of any such extension would be. Unless and until such legislation is enacted, beginning on January 1, 2010, withholding is required in respect of amounts paid in redemption of shares of a Fund by a greater-than-5% foreign shareholder if the Fund is a USRPHC, without regard to whether the Fund or any regulated investment company in which it invests is domestically controlled.

In order to qualify for any exemptions from withholding described above or for lower withholding tax rates under income tax treaties, or to establish an exemption from backup withholding, a foreign shareholder must comply with applicable certification requirements relating to its foreign status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN or substitute form). Foreign shareholders should consult their tax advisors in this regard.

Special rules (including withholding and reporting requirements) apply to foreign partnerships and those holding Fund shares through foreign partnerships. In addition, additional considerations may apply to foreign trusts and foreign estates. Investors holding Fund shares through foreign entities should consult their tax advisors about their particular situation.

If a Fund qualifies and makes an election to pass through foreign taxes to its shareholders, as described earlier, foreign shareholders of the Fund generally will be subject to increased U.S. federal income taxation without a corresponding benefit for the pass-through of foreign taxes.

 

151


Table of Contents

 

A beneficial holder of shares who is a foreign person may be subject to state and local tax and to the U.S. federal estate tax in addition to the U.S. federal income tax referred to above.

Tax-Exempt Shareholders

Under current law, a Fund serves to “block” (that is, prevent the attribution to shareholders of) UBTI from being realized by tax-exempt shareholders. Notwithstanding this “blocking” effect, a tax-exempt shareholder could realize UBTI by virtue of its investment in a Fund if shares in the Fund constitute debt-financed property in the hands of the tax-exempt shareholder within the meaning of Code Section 514(b).

It is possible that a tax-exempt shareholder will also recognize UBTI if a Fund recognizes excess inclusion income (as described above) derived from direct or indirect investments in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Furthermore, any investment in residual interests of a CMO that has elected to be treated as a REMIC can create complex tax consequences, especially if the Fund has state or local governments or other tax-exempt organizations as shareholders.

In addition, special tax consequences apply to charitable remainder trusts (CRTs) that invest in regulated investment companies that invest directly or indirectly in residual interests in REMICs or equity interests in TMPs. Under legislation enacted in December 2006, a CRT, as defined in Section 664 of the Code, that realizes UBTI for a taxable year must pay an excise tax annually of an amount equal to such UBTI. Under IRS guidance issued in October 2006, a CRT will not recognize UBTI solely as a result of investing in a Fund to the extent that it recognizes excess inclusion income. Rather, if at any time during any taxable year a CRT (or one of certain other tax-exempt shareholders, such as the United States, a state or political subdivision, or an agency or instrumentality thereof, and certain energy cooperatives) is a record holder of a share in a Fund and the Fund recognizes excess inclusion income, then the Fund will be subject to a tax on that portion of its excess inclusion income for the taxable year that is allocable to such shareholders at the highest U.S. federal corporate income tax rate. The extent to which the IRS guidance remains applicable in light of the December 2006 legislation is unclear. To the extent permitted under the 1940 Act, each Fund may elect to specially allocate any such tax to the applicable CRT, or other shareholder, and thus reduce such shareholder’s distributions for the year by the amount of the tax that relates to such shareholder’s interest in the Fund. Each Fund has not yet determined whether such an election will be made. CRTs are urged to consult their tax advisors concerning the consequences of investing in a Fund.

Shareholder Reporting Requirements Regarding Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts and Other Foreign Financial Assets

Effective for taxable years beginning after March 18, 2010, certain individuals (and, if provided in future guidance, certain domestic entities) must disclose annually their interests in “specified foreign financial assets” on their U.S. federal income tax returns. It is currently unclear under what circumstances, if any, a shareholder’s (indirect) interest in a Fund’s “specified foreign financial assets,” if any, falls within this requirement. In addition, shareholders that are U.S. persons and own, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of a Fund by vote or value could be required to report annually their “financial interest” in the Fund’s “foreign financial accounts,” if any, on Treasury Department Form TD F 90-22.1, Report of Foreign Bank and Financial Accounts (“FBAR”). Shareholders should consult a tax advisor regarding the applicability to them of both of these reporting requirements.

Other Reporting and Withholding Requirements

New rules enacted in March 2010 require the reporting to the IRS of direct and indirect ownership of foreign financial accounts and foreign entities by U.S. persons. Failure, including by a U.S. person, to provide this required information can result in a 30% withholding tax on certain payments (“withholdable payments”) made after December 31, 2012. Withholdable payments include U.S.-source dividends and interest, and gross proceeds from the sale or other disposal of property that can produce U.S.-source dividends or interest.

 

152


Table of Contents

 

The IRS has issued only limited guidance with respect to these new rules; their scope remains unclear and potentially subject to material change. Very generally, it appears that any distribution made by a Fund after December 31, 2012 (or such later date as may be provided in future guidance) to a shareholder, including a distribution in redemption of shares and a distribution of income or gains otherwise exempt from withholding under the rules applicable to non-U.S. shareholders described above (e.g., Capital Gain Dividends), will be subject to the new 30% withholding requirement. Payments to a foreign shareholder that is a “foreign financial institution” will generally be subject to withholding, unless such shareholder enters into an agreement with the IRS. Payments to shareholders that are U.S. persons or foreign individuals will generally not be subject to withholding, so long as such shareholders provide a Fund with such certifications or other documentation as the Fund requires to comply with the new rules. Persons investing in a Fund through an intermediary should contact their intermediary regarding the application of the new reporting and withholding regime to their investments in the Fund.

Shareholders are urged to consult a tax advisor regarding this new reporting and withholding regime, in light of their particular circumstances.

Tax Shelter Reporting Regulations

Under Treasury Regulations, if a shareholder recognizes a loss of $2 million or more for an individual shareholder or $10 million or more for a corporate shareholder, the shareholder must file with the IRS a disclosure statement on Form 8886. Direct shareholders of portfolio securities are in many cases excepted from this reporting requirement, but under current guidance, shareholders of a regulated investment company are not excepted. Future guidance may extend the current exception from this reporting requirement to shareholders of most or all regulated investment companies. The fact that a loss is reportable under these regulations does not affect the legal determination of whether the taxpayer’s treatment of the loss is proper. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors to determine the applicability of these regulations in light of their individual circumstances.

Special Tax Considerations Pertaining to Tax-Exempt Funds

If, at the close of each quarter of a regulated investment company’s taxable year, at least 50% of the value of its total assets consists of obligations the interest on which is exempt from U.S. federal income tax under Section 103(a) of the Code, then the regulated investment company may qualify to pay “exempt-interest dividends” and pass through to its shareholders the tax-exempt character of its income from such obligations. Certain of the Funds intend to so qualify and are designed to provide shareholders with a high level of income in the form of exempt-interest dividends, which are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax (such qualifying Funds, “the Tax-Exempt Funds”).

Distributions of capital gains or income not attributable to interest on Tax-Exempt Funds’ tax-exempt obligations will not constitute exempt-interest dividends and will be taxable to shareholders as described earlier.

Not later than 60 days after the close of a Tax-Exempt Fund’s taxable year, the Tax-Exempt Fund will notify its shareholders of the portion of the distributions for the taxable year which constitutes exempt-interest dividends. In general, if an amount of the Tax-Exempt Fund’s distribution designated as an exempt-interest dividend exceeds the fund’s net-exempt interest, the amount so qualifying as tax-exempt will be scaled back ratably to the amount of its net-exempt income. In such a case, each Tax-Exempt Fund shareholder must proportionately reduce the amount of the dividend it treats as tax-exempt, and will generally include the excess income as a taxable dividend to the extent of certain disallowed deductions and thereafter as a return of capital. The deductibility of interest paid or accrued on indebtedness incurred by a shareholder to purchase or carry shares of a Tax-Exempt Fund may be limited. The portion of such interest that is non-deductible generally equals the amount of such interest times the ratio of a Tax-Exempt Fund’s exempt-interest dividends received by the shareholder to all of the Tax-Exempt Fund’s dividends received by the shareholder (excluding Capital Gain Dividends and any capital gains required to be included in the shareholder’s long term capital gains in respect of capital gains retained by the Tax-Exempt Fund, as described earlier).

 

153


Table of Contents

 

Although exempt-interest dividends are generally exempt from U.S. federal income tax, there may not be a similar exemption under the laws of a particular state or local taxing jurisdiction. Thus, exempt-interest dividends may be subject to state and local taxes; however, eaxh state-specific Tax-Exempt Funds generally invests at least 80% of its net assets in municipal bonds that pay interest that is exempt not only from U.S. federal income tax, but also from the applicable state’s personal income tax (but not necessarily local taxes or taxes of other states). You should consult your tax advisor to discuss the tax consequences of your investment in a Tax-Exempt Fund.

Tax-exempt interest on certain “private activity bonds” has been designated as a “tax preference item” and must be added back to taxable income for purposes of calculating U.S. federal alternative minimum tax (“AMT”). To the extent that a Tax-Exempt Fund invests in certain private activity bonds, its shareholders will be required to report that portion of a Tax-Exempt Fund’s distributions attributable to income from the bonds as a tax preference item in determining their U.S. federal AMT, if any. Shareholders will be notified of the tax status of distributions made by a Tax-Exempt Fund. Persons who may be “substantial users” (or “related persons” of substantial users) of facilities financed by private activity bonds should consult their tax advisors before purchasing shares in a Tax-Exempt Fund. In addition, exempt-interest dividends paid by a Tax-Exempt Fund to a corporate shareholder are, with very limited exceptions, included in the shareholder’s “adjusted current earnings” as part of its U.S. federal AMT calculation. As of the date of this SAI, individuals are subject to the U.S. federal AMT at a maximum rate of 28% and corporations at a maximum rate of 20%. Shareholders with questions or concerns about the U.S. federal AMT should consult their own tax advisors.

Ordinarily, a Tax-Exempt Fund relies on an opinion from the issuer’s bond counsel that interest on the issuer’s obligation will be exempt from U.S. federal income taxation. However, no assurance can be given that the IRS will not successfully challenge such exemption, which could cause interest on the obligation to be taxable and could jeopardize a Tax-Exempt Fund’s ability to pay exempt-interest dividends. Similar challenges may occur as to state-specific exemptions. Also, from time to time legislation may be introduced or litigation may arise that would change the treatment of exempt-interest dividends. Such litigation or legislation may have the effect of raising the state or other taxes payable by shareholders on such dividends. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors for the current law on exempt-interest dividends.

A shareholder who receives Social Security or railroad retirement benefits should consult his or her tax advisor to determine what effect, if any, an investment in a Tax-Exempt Fund may have on the federal taxation of such benefits. Exempt-interest dividends are included in income for purposes of determining the amount of benefits that are taxable.

 

154


Table of Contents

 

CONTROL PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

As of September 30, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “principal holder” (i.e., owns of record or is known by the Trust to own beneficially 5% or more of any class of a Fund’s outstanding shares) is listed below.

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Bond Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     231,713.9370         13.88%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     128,858.1120         7.72%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     16,991.9580         6.48%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class C

  

WELLS FARGO INVESTMENTS LLC

625 MARQUETTE AVE FL 13

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55402-2323

     13,245.4760         5.05%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     261.0300         100.00%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     261.2970         100.00%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,792,527.4810         99.93%   

 

155


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     44,395,590.7660         61.41%   

Columbia Bond Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     4,737,302.7060         6.55%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     620,044.1290         7.11%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     641,588.8450         7.36%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     128,497.3820         22.27%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     234,458.5820         20.29%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     254.1810         100.00%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     254.1750         100.00%   

 

156


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     22,719,786.0950         59.54%   

Columbia Corporate Income Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     5,023,009.6700         13.16%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     147,904.2740         22.96%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     43,259.0470         27.49%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     10,035.0910         6.38%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class C

  

NFS LLC FEBO

FMT CO CUST R/O IRA

FBO ERIC K LIEW

3419 CROSS CREEK CIR

WOOSTER OH 44691-1863

     8,216.2920         5.22%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     213.4930         100.00%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     213.6750         100.00%   

 

157


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     213.6750         100.00%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     10,150,197.9010         31.06%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     8,889,579.8000         27.20%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     2,144,861.4930         6.56%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

SMALL GRAT LLC

35 EAGLE DR

SHARON MA 02067-2907

     2,112,423.0010         6.46%   

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     2,015,460.5900         6.17%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     214,418.7330         8.63%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     159,151.2010         6.41%   

 

158


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     138,725.2940         15.93%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     132.8370         100.00%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     133.2620         100.00%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     6,155,878.0700         19.19%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     6,140,791.7260         19.14%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     2,048,545.0140         6.39%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

TD AMERITRADE INC FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF OUR CLIENTS

P.O. BOX 2226

OMAHA NE 68103-2226

     1,649,852.0080         5.14%   

Columbia Energy & Natural Resources Fund

Class Z

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

     1,635,431.9370         5.10%   

 

159


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class A

  

NFS LLC FEBO

TRANSAMERICA LIFE INS COMPANY

1150 S OLIVE ST STE 2700

LOS ANGELES CA 90015-2211

     3,523,035.6830         18.82%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     654,794.7180         29.59%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     839,859.8690         23.36%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     456,912.3270         12.71%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     187,152.6570         5.21%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     271.5510         100.00%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

REGGIO REGISTER CO INC 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     42,853.8020         18.90%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     37,728.4780         16.64%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST COMPANY CUST, FBO

GREGORY PHILLIES, MD, PC

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

     18,019.8790         7.95%   

 

160


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

THOMAS J KING JR D D S PC P

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     14,940.0210         6.59%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

RAYMOND JAMES & ASSOC INC

FBO THOMAS C DAVIS & STEVEN J DAVIS TTEE

SB DAVIS COMPANY PSP

2695 ELMRIDGE DR NW

GRAND RAPIDS MI 49534-1302

     14,292.6100         6.31%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

AUBURN MANUFACTORING INC RETIREMENT

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     14,250.9170         6.29%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class R

  

MG TRUST CO CUST FBO

ALERT AMBULANCE SERVICE INC 401K

700 17TH ST STE 300

DENVER CO 80202-3531

     13,146.7720         5.80%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     271.5410         100.00%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     108,767,489.3180         50.20%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     14,809,519.3880         6.83%   

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

BOOK ENTRY ACCOUNT

ATTN: MATT MAESRI

MUTUAL FUNDS DEPT

333 W 34TH ST 7TH FL

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     12,546,091.5630         5.79%   

 

161


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT ADVISORS INC

FBO COL MODERATE GROWTH NY 529

ATTN: JIM MARIN

245 SUMMER ST FL 3

BOSTON MA 02210-1133

     11,200,007.2990         5.17%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

P.O. BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

     55,928.8560         43.67%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class A

  

PERSHING LLC

P.O. BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

     10,252.7010         8.01%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

     6,500.1570         5.08%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     2,677.2470         44.60%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

2801 MARKET ST

SAINT LOUIS MO 63103-2523

     1,899.6370         31.64%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

LPL FINANCIAL SERVICES

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

     733.6400         12.22%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class C

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

BETTY JEAN GHOSH TR

BETTY JEAN GHOSH TTEE

245 KUIKAHI ST

HILO HI 96720-2223

     518.4120         8.64%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     316.8570         100.00%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,454,249.1510         31.17%   

 

162


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     1,059,953.6000         22.72%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     689,282.3110         14.77%   

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     448,523.2660         9.61%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     55,033.4560         18.55%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     53,383.4870         17.99%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

BARCLAYS CAPITAL INC.

70 HUDSON STREET, 7TH FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07302-4585

     40,192.9260         13.55%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     39,009.9630         13.15%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     222.6180         100.00%   

 

163


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

WILMINGTON TRUST RISC CUST FBO

WATTEREDGE INC EMPLOYEE SP

P.O. BOX 52129

PHOENIX AZ 85072-2129

     32,236.3850         25.92%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

NETWORK ADJUSTERS INC 401

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     20,152.4090         16.20%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

CROSE & LEMKE CONSTRUCTION INC P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     16,854.7500         13.55%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

WILMINGTON TRUST RISC CUST FBO

INDUSTRIAL ENERGY

P.O. BOX 52129

PHOENIX AZ 85072-2129

     16,817.0710         13.52%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

ORCHARD TRUST CO LLC CUST

OPP FUNDS RECORDK PRO RET PL

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VILLAGE CO 80111

     14,565.8440         11.71%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

REGGIO REGISTER CO INC 401K

P.O. BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     11,303.0530         9.09%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

FRONTIER TRUST CO FBO

JACKSIN SERVICES INC 401K RETIR

PO BOX 10758

FARGO ND 58106-0758

     8,346.9230         6.71%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     224.0140         100.00%   

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     174,231,681.5130         84.37%   

 

164


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     14,103,428.4260         6.83%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,061,274.4000         25.34%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class A

  

PRUDENTIAL INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT SERVICES LLC FBO MUTUAL FUND CLIENTS

100 MULBERRY ST

NEWARK NJ 07102-4056

     214,763.4460         5.13%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     131,479.8590         28.71%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     155,004.3560         9.81%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     131,912.6590         8.35%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.6280         100.00%   

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     7,739,343.1240         30.12%   

 

165


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,658,883.9410         14.24%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     220,043.2390         15.07%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     118,452.3790         8.11%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     57.5110         100.00%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

DCGT AS TTEE AND/OR CUST

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED PRIN ADVTG OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH STREET

DES MOINES IA 50392-0001

     349,799.6330         26.16%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

DCGT AS TTEE AND/OR CUST

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED PRIN ADVTG OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH STREET

DES MOINES IA 50392-0001

     258,023.3540         19.30%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK CUST

FBO HUTAMAKI LONG TERM SAVINGS & INVESTMENT PLAN

C/O JPMORGAN RPS 5500 TEAM

9300 WARD PKWY

KANSAS CITY MO 64114-3317

     198,346.9220         14.84%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class R

  

JPMORGAN CHASE BANK CUST

FBO HUTAMAKI LONG TERM SAVINGS & INVESTMENT PLAN

C/O JPMORGAN RPS 5500 TEAM

9300 WARD PKWY

KANSAS CITY MO 64114-3317

     74,367.5070         5.56%   

 

166


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     57.4840         100.00%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     36,097,426.4100         27.49%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     20,424,748.5680         15.56%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     17,260,116.2440         13.15%   

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Class Z

  

JOHN HANCOCK LIFE INSURANCE CO USA

RPS SEG FUNDS & ACCOUNTING ET-7

601 CONGRESS ST

BOSTON MA 02210-2804

     7,670,245.0440         5.84%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending May 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     6,720,428.1240         13.90%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     4,206,538.9500         8.70%   

 

167


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     457,352.7670         13.33%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class B

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     336,888.5590         9.82%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     469,379.8150         14.22%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     170,452.1540         5.16%   

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     21,778,115.1400         76.46%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class A

  

LPL FINANCIAL

FBO CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS

ATTN MUTUAL FUND OPERATIONS

PO BOX 509046

SAN DIEGO CA 92150-9046

     18,954.6860         17.89%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     13,295.4930         12.55%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     6,491.0000         16.54%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class C

  

AMERICAN ENTERPRISE INVESTMENT SVCS

PO BOX 9446

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55440-9446

     2,824.4790         7.20%   

 

168


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     220.4590         100.00%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     820,950.2480         59.81%   

Columbia International Bond Fund

Class Z

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     516,099.7760         37.60%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     17,139,026.3850         10.32%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,512,579.0500         25.43%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     9,631,716.6250         29.10%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     1,863,775.5590         5.63%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     405.8440         100.00%   

 

169


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     405.8440         100.00%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     83,245,905.4230         71.01%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     9,992,474.6940         8.52%   

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     6,348,121.9690         5.42%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending June 30:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     2,898,947.8830         35.14

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class A

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     518,408.6020         6.28

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     205,867.2160         36.48

 

170


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     323,169.4900         32.44

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class C

  

LPL FINANCIAL SERVICES

9785 TOWNE CENTRE DR

SAN DIEGO CA 92121-1968

     54,017.2680         5.42

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     57,791,398.9660         81.53

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class A

  

ORCHARD TRUST COMPANY LLC TTEE

FBO EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CLIENTS 401(K) PLAN

8515 E ORCHARD RD #2T2

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     863,978.5170         5.32

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     857,698.9710         5.28

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class A

  

DCGT AS TTEE AND/OR CUST

FBO PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL GROUP QUALIFIED FIA OMNIBUS

ATTN NPIO TRADE DESK

711 HIGH ST

DES MOINES IA 50392-001

     847,944.5300         5.22

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     63,970.2730         9.40

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     330,773.3610         21.60

 

171


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     89,658.9020         5.85%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     87,817.7670         5.73%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     61.8810         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     65.0530         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     28,342.1690         98.89%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     5,171,440.5480         24.27%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

EDWARD D JONES & CO

MUTUAL FUND SHAREHOLDER ACCOUNTING

201 PROGRESS PKWY

MARYLAND HTS MO 63043-3009

     2,437,484.6220         11.44%   

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,297,671.7490         6.09%   

 

172


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     1,285,600.5530         6.03

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending August 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class A

  

TAYNIK & CO

C/O INVESTORS BANK & TRUST CO

200 CLARENDON ST #FPG90

BOSTON MA 02116-5021

     282,965.6610         9.37

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     163,972.1100         5.43

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class A

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     155,186.3500         5.14

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     65,840.3590         23.03

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class B

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     18,691.0110         6.54

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     182,062.5900         16.33

 

173


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     160,656.5000         14.41%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     127,157.7540         11.41%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     101.5430         100.00%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,380,710.7190         15.37%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     546,028.1750         6.08%   

Columbia Balanced Fund

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

REGIONS BANK DBA KENNEBURT CO

250 RIVERCHASE PKWY E FL 5

BIRMINGHAM AL 35244-1832

     488,272.9300         5.44%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     746,691.5880         23.21%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     90,385.5020         31.02%   

 

174


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     91,133.9560         17.33%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     61,854.3100         11.76%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     107.6190         100.00%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

PALACE ENTERTAINMENT TTEE FBO

PALACE ENTERTAINMENT 401K

C/O FASCORE LLC

8515 E ORCHARD RD #2T2

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     29,872.0110         12.13%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

COUNSEL TRUST DBA MATC FBO

ANDERSON & VREELAND INC PSP

1251 WATERFRONT PL STE 525

PITTSBURGH PA 15222-4228

     25,872.0820         10.50%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     22,752.8750         9.24%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

CAPITAL BANK & TRUST CO

TTEE F FALASCA MECHANICAL INC

401K

8515 E ORCHARD RD #2T2

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     13,292.9880         5.40%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     164,348.5380         17.16%   

 

175


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     110.2780         100.00%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class Y

  

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GLOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     619.0670         100.00%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     19,841,200.6310         42.06%   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     2,957,559.1610         6.27%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     9,135.3190         9.95%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     183,419.5700         30.05%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     93.0750         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     94.2680         100.00%   

 

176


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Y

  

ANCHORAGE POLICE & FIRE RETIREMENT SYSTEM

ATTN CHARLES M LAIRD

3600 DR MARTIN LUTHER KING JR AVE

STE 207

ANCHORAGE AK 99507-1222

     574,338.8870         99.91%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,930,461.6990         50.48%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     3,020,180.4990         10.21%   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Class Z

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

     1,905,578.3390         6.44%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     605,226.9980         6.64%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     366,932.3080         27.69%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     195,471.8960         18.33%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     146.9720         100.00%   

 

177


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     147.3190         100.00%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     147.3190         100.00%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     625,701.5030         99.88%   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     2,113,685.8780         6.22%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending September 30:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     55,204.9040         16.30%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     400,538.8090         25.71%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     196.8500         100.00%   

 

178


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     198.0980         100.00%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     2,904,076.6610         32.18%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     198.0980         100.00%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     11,895,818.9480         43.85%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL GROWTH PORTFOLIO

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     1,742,073.6190         6.37%   

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Class Z

  

STATE STREET BANK & TRUST COMPANY

AAF LIFEGOAL BALANCED GROWTH

ATTN JIM BOTSOLIS

TWO AVENUE DE LAFAYETTE

BOSTON MA 02111-1724

     1,646,036.7240         6.07%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,833,676.4450         6.39%   

 

179


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     323,006.5390         18.13%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,679,694.0770         21.34%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     505,894.0470         6.43%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     205.9310         100.00%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class R

  

NFS LLC FEBO

STATE STREET BANK TRUST CO

TTEE VARIOUS RETIREMENT PLANS

4 MANHATTANVILLE RD

PURCHASE NY 10577-2139

     354,054.4290         50.12%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class R

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     72,943.3090         10.33%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class R

  

CAPITAL BANK & TRUST CO

TTEE F CHEMGLASS INC 401K

8515 E ORCHARD RD

GREENWOOD VLG CO 80111-5002

     48,596.2770         6.88%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class T

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     1,729,484.3090         26.07%   

 

180


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,052,218.9670         15.86%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     206.1010         100.00%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     76,073,223.1810         58.11%   

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     9,604,889.3720         7.34%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     501,887.3690         6.97%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     93,881.2820         12.24%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     144,483.2790         17.15%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

BRIDGET NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O CHRISTOPHER M NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     3,133.0250         13.97%   

 

181


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

ANDREW NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O CHRISTOPHER M NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     3,132.6550         13.97%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

KAYLA HALL

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O MAUREEN HALL

49 RAYMOND PL

STATEN ISLAND NY 10310-2231

     2,804.7220         12.51%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

MIRANDA E KRAMER

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O LEIGH A NEUMANN

5203 SILVER FOX DR

JAMESVILLE NY 13078-8742

     2,617.7510         11.67%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

CLAIRE NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O ROBERT S NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     2,587.8420         11.54%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

LILY ELIZABETH KRAMER

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O LEIGH A NEUMANN

5203 SILVER FOX DR

JAMESVILLE NY 13078-8742

     2,582.3600         11.51%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class F

  

MATTHEW PATRICK NEUMANN

ADVANTAGE PLAN TRUST

C/O CHRISTOPHER M NEUMANN

2923 E LAKE RD

SKANEATELES NY 13152-9003

     2,572.5710         11.47%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     118.0360         100.00%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     120.8900         100.00%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,850,615.3180         26.36%   

 

182


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class W

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     120.8900         100.00%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Y

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,053,087.9350         99.94%   

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     15,661,903.8570         38.14%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     725,948.6660         7.96%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class A

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     456,353.2080         5.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     237,992.1060         18.27%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     223,748.8400         13.55%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS, INC.

ATTN: PETER BOOTH 7TH FL

333 W 34TH ST

NEW YORK NY 10001-2402

     129,811.4340         7.86%   

 

183


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     100,824.8620         6.11%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     186.9860         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class T

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,853,281.8600         32.82%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     192.1600         100.00%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,295,990.1260         47.59%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     3,431,874.4850         11.42%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     2,230,417.1550         7.43%   

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Class Z

  

FIDELITY INVSTMNTS INSTITUTIONAL OPERATING CO FIIOC AGENT

FBO CERTAIN EMP BENEFIT PLANS

100 MAGELLAN WAY

COVINGTON KY 41015-1987

     1,612,451.1200         5.37%   

 

184


Table of Contents

 

Principal Holder Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending October 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class A

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     1,458,758.9220         14.36%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     127,193.2490         31.57%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class C

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     378,486.5220         23.66%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class C

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     111,582.9250         6.98%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class C

  

PERSHING LLC

PO BOX 2052

JERSEY CITY NJ 07303-2052

     94,050.7650         5.88%   

Columbia CT Tax-Exempt Fund

Class Z

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     313.3810         100.00%   

Principal Holder Ownership of the Fund with fiscal year ending December 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class A

  

FIRST CLEARING LLC

BARRETT A TOAN & PAULA OBRIAN JT TEN

42 PORTLAND PL

SAINT LOUIS MO 63108-1242

     246,430.2830         11.89%   

 

185


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of class
 

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class A

  

MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY

HARBORSIDE FINANCIAL CENTER

PLAZA 2, 3RD FL

JERSEY CITY NJ 07311

     198,900.1270         9.64%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class B

  

MERRILL LYNCH PIERCE FENNER & SMITH FOR THE SOLE BENEFIT OF ITS CUSTOMERS

ATTN FUND ADMINISTRATION

4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2

JACKSONVILLE FL 32246-6484

     38,577.2290         14.49%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class I

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.4040         100.00%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class R

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.7660         100.00%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class W

  

COLUMBIA MGMT INVESTMENT ADVSR LLC

ATTN T ARMBRUSTMACHER & V GEHLHAR

50807 AMERIPRISE FINANCIAL CTR

MINNEAPOLIS MN 55474-0508

     212.7660         100.00%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class Z

  

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     10,537,887.6510         37.22%   

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Class Z

  

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     5,884,378.3790         20.78%   

 

186


Table of Contents

 

As of September 30, 2010, the name, address and percentage of ownership of each person who may be deemed to be a “control person” (as that term is defined in the 1940 Act) of a Fund because it owns of record more than 25% of the outstanding shares of the Fund by virtue of its fiduciary roles with respect to its clients or otherwise, is shown below. A control person may be able to facilitate shareholder approval of proposals it approves and to impede shareholder approval of proposals it opposes. If a control person’s record ownership of a Fund’s outstanding shares exceeds 50%, then, for certain shareholder proposals, such control person may be able to approve, or prevent approval, of such proposals without regard to votes by other Fund shareholders.

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending March 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Bond Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     46,188,118.2470         60.75
Columbia Corporate Income Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     22,719,786.0950         46.74
Columbia Emerging Markets Fund   

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     10,150,197.5000         30.32
Columbia Emerging Markets Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     8,889,579.8000         26.55
Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     108,767,489.3180         45.05
Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     1,454,249.1510         30.30

 

187


Table of Contents

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     174,231,681.5130         62.53
Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund   

CHARLES SCHWAB & CO INC

SPECIAL CUSTODY ACCOUNT FOR THE EXCLUSIVE BENEFIT OF CUSTOMERS

ATTN MUTUAL FUNDS

101 MONTGOMERY STREET

SAN FRANCISCO CA 94104-4151

     36,097,426.4100         25.82

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending May 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     21,778,115.1400         26.07
Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     57,791,398.9660         71.62
Columbia International Bond Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     820,950.2480         54.08
Columbia International Bond Fund   

FIM FUNDING INC

C/O BOFA GOBAL CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

100 FEDERAL ST

BOSTON MA 02110-1802

     516,099.7760         34.00
Columbia Strategic Income Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     83,245,905.4230         25.21

 

188


Table of Contents

 

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending August 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     19,841,200.6310         37.86
Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,930,461.6990         44.56

Control Person Ownership of the Funds with fiscal year ending September 30:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Contrarian Core Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     11,895,878.9480         25.40
Columbia Dividend Income Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     76,073,223.1810         58.11
Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     16,714,991.7920         28.53
Columbia Small Cap Core Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     14,295,990.1260         29.93

 

189


Table of Contents

 

Control Person Ownership of the Fund with fiscal year ending December 31:

 

Fund

  

Shareholder Account Registration

   Share Balance      Percentage
of Fund
 
Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund   

BANK OF AMERICA NA, TRUSTEE

ATTN BETTY BARLEY/FUNDS ACCOUNTING

1201 MAIN STREET 10TH FL

DALLAS TX 75202-3908

     10,537,887.6510         33.79

Bank of America, N.A. is a national banking association organized under the laws of the United States, 101 South Tryon Street, Charlotte, North Carolina 28255. Bank of America Corporation, a publicly-traded financial services corporation, is the ultimate parent company of Bank of America, N.A.

Charles Schwab & Co., Inc. is organized under the laws of the United States, 211 Main Street, San Francisco, California 94105. The Charles Schwab Corporation is the ultimate parent company of Charles Schwab & Co., Inc.

 

190


Table of Contents

 

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In June 2004, an action captioned John E. Gallus et al. v. American Express Financial Corp. and American Express Financial Advisors Inc., was filed in the United States District Court for the District of Arizona. The plaintiffs allege that they are investors in several American Express Company (now known as RiverSource) mutual funds and they purport to bring the action derivatively on behalf of those funds under the 1940 Act. The plaintiffs allege that fees allegedly paid to the defendants by the funds for investment advisory and administrative services are excessive. The plaintiffs seek remedies including restitution and rescission of investment advisory and distribution agreements. The plaintiffs voluntarily agreed to transfer this case to the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota (the District Court). In response to defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint, the District Court dismissed one of plaintiffs’ four claims and granted plaintiffs limited discovery. Defendants moved for summary judgment in April 2007. Summary judgment was granted in the defendants’ favor on July 9, 2007. The plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal with the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals (the Eighth Circuit) on August 8, 2007. On April 8, 2009, the Eighth Circuit reversed summary judgment and remanded to the District Court for further proceedings. On August 6, 2009, defendants filed a writ of certiorari with the U.S. Supreme Court (the Supreme Court), asking the Supreme Court to stay the District Court proceedings while the Supreme Court considered and ruled in a case captioned Jones v. Harris Associates, which involved issues of law similar to those presented in the Gallus case. On March 30, 2010, the Supreme Court issued its ruling in Jones v. Harris Associates, and on April 5, 2010, the Supreme Court vacated the Eighth Circuit’s decision in the Gallus case and remanded the case to the Eighth Circuit for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates. On June 4, 2010, the Eighth Circuit remanded the Gallus case to the District Court for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates.

In December 2005, without admitting or denying the allegations, American Express Financial Corporation (AEFC, which is now known as Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (Ameriprise Financial)), entered into settlement agreements with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and Minnesota Department of Commerce (MDOC) related to market timing activities. As a result, AEFC was censured and ordered to cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of certain provisions of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, the 1940 Act, and various Minnesota laws. AEFC agreed to pay disgorgement of $10 million and civil money penalties of $7 million. AEFC also agreed to retain an independent distribution consultant to assist in developing a plan for distribution of all disgorgement and civil penalties ordered by the SEC in accordance with various undertakings detailed at http://www.sec.gov/litigation/admin/ia-2451.pdf. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have cooperated with the SEC and the MDOC in these legal proceedings, and have made regular reports to the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds’ Boards of Directors/Trustees.

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions, and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that the Funds are not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial nor any of its affiliates are the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds. Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the SEC on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

There can be no assurance that these matters, or the adverse publicity associated with them, will not result in increased fund redemptions, reduced sale of fund shares or other adverse consequences to the Funds. Further, although we believe proceedings are not likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds, these proceedings are subject to uncertainties and, as such, we are unable to estimate the possible loss or range of loss that may result. An adverse outcome in one or more of these proceedings could result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties or other relief that could have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations of Ameriprise Financial.

 

191


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A — DESCRIPTIONS OF SECURITIES RATINGS

This Appendix summarizes the various descriptions of securities ratings applicable to securities purchased by the Columbia Funds. Please refer to a Fund’s prospectus and statement of additional information to determine whether that Fund may invest in securities that have ratings described in this Appendix.

STANDARD & POOR’S (S&P)

Bonds

The following summarizes the ratings used by S&P for bonds. The ratings AAA, AA, A and BBB denote investment grade securities.

AAA bonds have the highest rating assigned by S&P and are considered to have an extremely strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

AA bonds are considered to have a very strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, and they differ from AAA only in small degree.

A bonds are considered to have a strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher rated categories.

BBB bonds are considered to have an adequate capacity to pay interest and repay principal. Whereas they normally exhibit adequate protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity to pay interest and repay principal than for bonds in the A category.

BB, B, CCC, CC and C bonds are considered to have predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation. BB indicates the lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree. While such debt will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or large exposures to adverse conditions.

BB bonds are considered to have less near-term vulnerability to default than other speculative issues. However, they face major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments. The BB rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BBB – rating.

B bonds are considered to have a greater vulnerability to default but currently have the capacity to meet interest payments and principal repayments. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to pay interest and repay principal. The B rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BB or BB – rating.

CCC bonds are considered to have a currently identifiable vulnerability to default, and are dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions to meet timely payment of interest and repayment of principal. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the bonds are not likely to have the capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The CCC rating category is also used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied B or B – rating.

CC rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC rating.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

C rating typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC – debt rating. The C rating may be used to cover a situation, for example, where a bankruptcy petition has been filed, but debt service payments are continued.

CI rating is reserved for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

D bonds are in payment default. The D rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments are not made on the date due even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made during such grace period. The D rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.

Plus (+) or minus (-): The ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus or minus sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

Municipal Notes

SP-1. Notes rated SP-1 are considered to have very strong or strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designated as SP-1+.

SP-2. Notes rated SP-2 are considered to have satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest.

Notes due in three years or less normally receive a note rating. Notes maturing beyond three years normally receive a bond rating, although the following criteria are used in making that assessment:

Amortization schedule (the larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely the issue will be rated as a note).

Source of payment (the more dependent the issue is on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it will be rated as a note).

Commercial Paper

A. Issues assigned this highest rating are regarded as having the greatest capacity for timely payment. Issues in this category are further refined with the designations 1, 2, and 3 to indicate the relative degree of safety.

A-1. Issues assigned to this rating are considered to have overwhelming or very strong capacity for timely payment. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are designed A-1+.

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. (MOODY’S)

Municipal Bonds

Aaa bonds are considered to be of the best quality. They are considered to have the smallest degree of investment risk and are generally referred to as “gilt edge”. Interest payments are protected by a large or by an exceptionally stable margin and principal is secure. While various protective elements are likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair a fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Aa bonds are considered to be of high quality by all standards. Together with Aaa bonds they comprise what are generally known as high-grade bonds. They are rated lower than the best bonds because margins of protection may not be as large in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective elements may be of greater amplitude or there may be other elements present which make the long-term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

 

A-2


Table of Contents

 

Those bonds in the Aa through B groups that Moody’s believes possess the strongest investment attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1, A1 or Baa1.

A bonds are considered to possess many favorable investment attributes and are to be considered to be upper-medium-grade obligations. Factors giving security to principal and interest are considered adequate, but elements may be present that suggest a susceptibility to impairment at some time in the future.

Baa bonds are considered to be medium grade obligations: they are neither highly protected nor poorly secured. Interest payments and principal security appear adequate for the present but certain protective elements may be lacking or may be characteristically unreliable over any great period of time. Such bonds lack outstanding investment characteristics and, in fact, have speculative characteristics as well.

Ba bonds are considered to have speculative elements: their future cannot be considered as well secured. Often, the protection of interest and principal payments may be very moderate and thereby not well safeguarded during both good and bad times in the future. Uncertainty of position characterizes bonds in this grade.

B bonds are considered generally to lack characteristics of a desirable investment. Assurance of interest and principal payments or of maintenance of other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Caa bonds are considered to be of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Ca bonds are considered to represent obligations that are speculative in a high degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

C bonds are the lowest rated class of bonds and issues so rated are considered to have extremely poor prospects of ever attaining any real investment standing.

Conditional Ratings. Bonds for which the security depends upon the completion of some act or the fulfillment of some condition are rated conditionally. These are bonds secured by (a) earnings of projects under construction, (b) earnings of projects unseasoned in operating experience, (c) rentals which begin when facilities are completed, or (d) payments to which some other limiting conditions attach. Parenthetical rating denotes probable credit stature upon completion of construction or elimination of basis of condition.

Corporate Bonds

The description of the applicable rating symbols (Aaa, Aa, A, Baa, etc.) and their meanings is identical to that of the Municipal Bond ratings as set forth above, except for the numerical modifiers. Moody’s applies numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 in the Aa and A classifications of its corporate bond rating system. The modifier 1 indicates that the security ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a midrange ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates that the issuer ranks in the lower end of its generic rating category.

Municipal Notes

MIG 1. This designation denotes best quality. There is present strong protection by established cash flows, superior liquidity support or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.

MIG 2. This designation denotes high quality. Margins of protection are ample although not so large as in the preceding group.

 

A-3


Table of Contents

 

MIG 3. This designation denotes favorable quality. All security elements are accounted for, but there is lacking the undeniable strength of the preceding grades. Liquidity and cash flow protection may be narrow and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.

Commercial Paper

Moody’s employs the following three designations, all judged to be investment grade, to indicate the relative repayment capacity of rated issuers:

Prime-1 Highest Quality

Prime-2 Higher Quality

Prime-3 High Quality

If an issuer represents to Moody’s that its commercial paper obligations are supported by the credit of another entity or entities, Moody’s, in assigning ratings to such issuers, evaluates the financial strength of the indicated affiliated corporations, commercial banks, insurance companies, foreign governments, or other entities, but only as one factor in the total rating assessment.

FITCH, INC. (FITCH)

Long-Term Debt

Investment Grade Bond Ratings

AAA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of the highest credit quality. The obligor has an exceptionally strong ability to pay interest and/or dividends and repay principal, which is unlikely to be affected by reasonably foreseeable events.

AA bonds are considered to be investment grade and of very high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is very strong, although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA. Because bonds rated in the AAA and AA categories are not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable future developments, short-term debt of these issuers is generally rated F-1+.

A bonds are considered to be investment grade and of high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered to be strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances than debt securities with higher ratings.

BBB bonds are considered to be investment grade and of satisfactory credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest or dividends and repay principal is considered to be adequate. Adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances, however, are more likely to have adverse impact on these securities and, therefore, impair timely payment. The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall below investment grade is higher than for securities with higher ratings.

Speculative Grade Bond Ratings

BB bonds are considered speculative. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes. However, business and financial alternatives can be identified, which could assist the obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B bonds are considered highly speculative. While securities in this class are currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely payment of principal and interest reflects the obligor’s limited margin of safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the life of the issue.

 

A-4


Table of Contents

 

CCC bonds are considered to have certain identifiable characteristics that, if not remedied, may lead to default. The ability to meet obligations requires an advantageous business and economic environment.

CC bonds are considered to be minimally protected. Default in payment of interest and/or principal seems probable over time.

C bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments. Such securities are extremely speculative and should be valued on the basis of their ultimate recovery value in liquidation or reorganization of the obligor. DDD represents the highest potential for recovery on these securities and D represents the lowest potential for recovery.

Plus (+) or minus (-): Plus or minus signs are used to show relative standing within the major rating categories. Plus and minus signs, however, are not used in the DDD, DD, or D categories.

Short-Term Debt

Fitch’s short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand or have original maturities of up to three years, including commercial paper, certificates of deposit, medium-term notes, and investment notes.

F-1+ obligations have exceptionally strong credit quality and are considered to have the strongest degree of assurance for timely payment.

F-1 obligations are considered to reflect an assurance of timely payment only slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2 obligations are considered to have good credit quality. Securities in this class have a satisfactory degree of assurance for timely payment, but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned F-1+ and F-1 ratings.

F-3 obligations are considered to have characteristics suggesting that the degree of assurance for timely payment is adequate; however, near-term adverse changes could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a minimal degree of assurance for timely payment and to be vulnerable to near-term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions.

B obligations are considered to have a minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments and a susceptibility to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

C rating is assigned to obligations that are considered to have a high default risk and whose capacity for meeting financial commitments is solely reliant upon a sustained, favorable business and economic environment.

D obligations are in actual or imminent payment default.

 

A-5


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B — PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT INVESTMENT ADVISERS, LLC

PROXY VOTING POLICY FOR LEGACY COLUMBIA MANAGEMENT CLIENTS

EFFECTIVE MAY 1, 2010

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (CMIA) has adopted the attached Proxy Voting Policy for purposes of voting proxies of securities held in certain client accounts1, with the following changes:

 

   

References to Columbia Management Advisors, LLC and CMA are deemed to be references to Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC; and

 

   

References to Bank of America Corporation and BAC are deemed to be references to Ameriprise Financial, Inc.

In addition, the text of footnote 1 in the Proxy Voting Policy is hereby deleted and replaced with the following:

Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the corporate parent of Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, and all of its numerous affiliates own, operate and have interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between Ameriprise Financial, Inc. or its affiliates and those of clients advised by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC. For example, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. and its affiliates may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

1 On April 30, 2010, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., the parent company of CMIA, acquired from Bank of America, N.A. a portion of the asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC, the parent company of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”). In connection with this transaction, CMIA became the investment adviser of certain client accounts previously advised by CMA. CMIA will apply CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy to certain of these and other client accounts.

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) Proxy Voting Policy

 

Last Review Date:

   April 2010
Applicable Regulatory Authority:   

Rule 206(4)-6 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940

Form N-PX

ERISA Department of Labor Bulletin 08-2

Institutional Shareholder Services, Inc. (SEC No Action Letter dated September 15, 2004)

Explanation/Summary of Regulatory Requirements

An investment adviser that exercises voting authority over clients’ proxies must adopt written policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that those proxies are voted in the best economic interests of clients. An adviser’s policies and procedures must address how the adviser resolves material conflicts of interest between its interests and those of its clients. An investment adviser must comply with certain record keeping and disclosure requirements with respect to its proxy voting responsibilities. In addition, an investment adviser to Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) accounts has an affirmative obligation to vote proxies for an ERISA account, unless the client expressly retains proxy voting authority.

Policy Summary

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC (“CMA”) has adopted and implemented the following policy, which it believes is reasonably designed to: (1) ensure that proxies are voted in the best economic interest of clients; and (2) address material conflicts of interest that may arise. This policy applies primarily to the Global Wealth and Investment Management (“GWIM”) Investment Operations Group, the Investment groups (particularly, Equity and Chief Investment Officer’s Office), as well as to Compliance Risk Management (“CRM”) and Legal. CRM and Business groups to which this policy directly applies must adopt written procedures to implement this Policy.

Policy

All proxies regarding client securities for which CMA has authority to vote will, unless CMA determines in accordance with policies stated below to refrain from voting, be voted in a manner considered by CMA to be in the best interest of CMA’s clients without regard to any resulting benefit or detriment to CMA, its associates, or its affiliates. The best interest of clients is defined for this purpose as the interest of enhancing or protecting the economic value of client accounts, considered as a group rather than individually, as CMA determines in its sole and absolute discretion. In the event a client believes that its other interests require a different vote, CMA will vote as the client clearly instructs, provided CMA receives such instructions in time to act accordingly. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential. Therefore, the information may be shared on a need to know basis only, including within CMA and with CMA affiliates. Advisory clients, including mutual funds’ and other funds’ boards, may obtain information on how their proxies were voted by CMA. However, CMA will not selectively disclose its investment company clients’ proxy voting records to third parties. Rather, the investment company clients’ proxy records will be disclosed to shareholders by publicly-available annual filings for 12-month periods ending each year on June 30th on Form N-PX.

CMA endeavors to vote, in accordance with this Policy, all proxies of which it becomes aware prior to the vote deadline date, subject to certain general exceptions described below.

CMA seeks to avoid the occurrence of actual or apparent material conflicts of interest in the proxy voting process by voting in accordance with predetermined voting guidelines and observing other procedures that are intended to prevent where practicable and manage conflicts of interest (refer to Conflicts of Interest section below). CMA’s proxy voting policy and practices are summarized in its Form ADV. Additionally, CMA will provide clients with a copy of its policies, as they may be updated from time to time, upon request.

 

B-2


Table of Contents

 

Means of Achieving Compliance

The Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations is primarily responsible for overseeing the day-to-day operations of the proxy voting process. The Proxy Group’s monitoring will take into account the following elements: (1) periodic review of the proxy vendor’s votes to ensure that the proxy vendor is accurately voting consistent with CMA’s Voting Guidelines; and (2) review of the Columbia Funds’ fund website to ensure that annual proxy voting reports are posted in a timely and accurate manner. CMA has established a Proxy Committee which is responsible for overseeing the proxy voting process.

The specific responsibilities of the Proxy Committee and scope of its oversight are described in the Proxy Committee’s charter.

CMA’S INVESTMENT ASSOCIATES’ RESPONSIBILITIES

Under CMA’s Voting Guidelines, certain matters must be determined on a case-by-case basis. In general, the Proxy Group within GWIM Investment Operations will refer these matters first to the relevant CMA research analyst after first confirming that the proxy matter does not present a potential conflict to CMA. If there is not a research analyst assigned to the particular security, the matter will be referred to the appropriate portfolio manager.

In considering a particular proxy matter, the research analyst or portfolio manager must vote in the clients’ best interest as defined above. Information regarding CMA’s proxy voting decisions is confidential information. Therefore, research analysts and portfolio managers generally must not discuss proxy votes with any person outside of CMA and within CMA except on a need to know basis only.

Research analysts and portfolio managers must discharge their responsibilities consistent with the obligations set forth below (refer to Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures). A research analyst or portfolio manager must disclose in writing any inappropriate attempt to influence their recommendation or any other personal interest that they have with the issuer (see Appendix B – Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form). For each Proxy Referral (defined below), the research analyst or portfolio manager is responsible for memorializing their recommendation on the Proxy Voting Recommendation Form (see Appendix C) and communicating their recommendation to the Proxy Group.

Research analysts and portfolio managers should seek advice from CRM or Legal with respect to any questions that they have regarding personal conflicts of interests, communications regarding proxies, or other related matters.

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

For purposes of this policy, a material conflict of interest is a relationship or activity engaged in by CMA, a CMA affiliate1, or a CMA associate that creates an incentive (or appearance thereof) to favor the interests of CMA, the affiliate, or associate, rather than the clients’ interests. However, a material conflict of interest is not automatically created when there is a relationship or activity engaged in by a CMA affiliate, but there is a possibility that a CMA affiliate could cause a conflict. CMA may have a conflict of interest if either CMA has a significant business relationship with a company that is soliciting a proxy, or if a CMA associate involved in the proxy voting decision-making process has a significant personal or family relationship with the particular

 

1 Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”), the ultimate corporate parent of CMA, Bank of America, N.A. and all of their numerous affiliates owns, operates and has interests in many lines of business that may create or give rise to the appearance of a conflict of interest between BAC or its affiliates and those of CMA-advised clients. For example, the commercial and investment banking business lines may have interests with respect to issuers of voting securities that could appear to or even actually conflict with CMA’s duty, in the proxy voting process, to act in the best economic interest of its clients.

 

B-3


Table of Contents

company. A conflict of interest is considered to be “material” to the extent that a reasonable person could expect the conflict to influence CMA’s decision on the particular vote at issue. In all cases where there is deemed to be a material conflict of interest, CMA will seek to resolve said conflict in the clients’ best interests.

For those proxy proposals that: (1) are not addressed by CMA’s proxy voting guidelines; (2) the guidelines specify the issue must be evaluated and determined on a case-by-case basis; or (3) a CMA investment associate believes that an exception to the guidelines may be in the best economic interest of CMA’s clients (collectively, “Proxy Referrals”), CMA may vote the proxy, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures set forth below.

In the case of Proxy Referrals, CRM identifies companies with which CMA has a significant business relationships and Proxy Referrals of such companies will be voted consistent with CMA’s conflicts management procedures described below. For Proxy Referrals that do not involve companies with which CMA has a significant business relationship the relevant CMA investment personnel (i.e. research analyst, portfolio manager, members of Proxy Committee) involved in the particular Proxy Referral must report any personal conflict of interest circumstances (e.g., relationships with nominees for directorship, members of an issuer’s or dissident’s management or otherwise, unusual communications with parties outside the investment organization concerning a proxy matter) to Columbia Management’s Conflicts of Interest Officer in writing (see Appendix B). In the event any member of the Proxy Committee has a conflict of interest regarding a given matter, he or she will similarly disclose the circumstance and abstain from participating in the Committee’s determination of whether and/or how to vote in the matter.

If the Proxy Committee, the Chairperson of the Proxy Committee, or the Conflicts Officer determines that a proxy matter presents a material conflict of interest, or a material conflict of interest is otherwise determined to exist through the application of this Policy, CMA will invoke one or more of the following conflict management procedures:

 

   

Causing the proxies to be voted in accordance with the recommendations of an independent third party (which generally will be CMA’s proxy voting agent);

 

   

Causing the proxies to be delegated to a qualified, independent third party, which may include CMA’s proxy voting agent; or

 

   

In unusual cases, with the Client’s consent and upon ample notice, forwarding the proxies to CMA’s clients so that they may vote the proxies directly.

Affiliate Investment Companies and Public Companies

CMA considers (1) proxies solicited by open-end and closed-end investment companies for which CMA or an affiliate serves as an investment adviser or principal underwriter; and (2) proxies solicited by Bank of America Corporation (“BAC”) or other public companies within the BAC organization to present a material conflict of interest for CMA. Consequently, the proxies of such affiliates will be voted following one of the conflict management practices discussed above.

Management of Conflicts of Interest – Additional Procedures

In certain circumstances, CMA follows the proxy guidelines and uses other research services provided by the proxy vendor or another independent third party. CMA reviews its proxy vendor’s conflicts of interest procedures as part of its oversight of the proxy vendor’s services.

CMA and other BAC affiliates have adopted various other policies and procedures that help reinforce this Policy. Please see any associated documents.

Ownership Limits – Delegation of Proxy Voting to an Independent Third Party

From time to time, CMA may face regulatory or compliance limits on the types or amounts of voting securities that it may purchase or hold for client accounts. Among other limits, federal, state, foreign regulatory restrictions, or company-specific ownership limits may restrict the total percentage of an issuer’s voting securities that CMA can hold for clients (collectively, “Ownership Limits”).

 

B-4


Table of Contents

 

The regulations or company-specific documents governing a number of these Ownership Limits often focus upon holdings in voting securities. As a result, in limited circumstances in order to comply with such Ownership Limits and/or internal policies designed to comply with such limits, CMA may delegate proxy voting in certain issuers to a qualified, independent third party, who may be CMA’s proxy voting agent.

PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES

A. CMA’s Proxy Voting Guidelines – General Practices.

The Proxy Committee has adopted the guidelines for voting proxies specified in Appendix A of this policy. CMA uses an independent, third-party proxy vendor to implement its proxy voting process as CMA’s proxy voting agent. In general, whenever a vote is solicited, the proxy vendor will execute the vote according to CMA’s Voting Guidelines.

B. Ability to Vote Proxies Other than as Provided by Voting Guidelines.

A Portfolio Manager or other party involved with a client’s account may conclude that the best interest of the firm’s client, as defined above, requires that a proxy be voted in a manner that differs from the predetermined proxy Voting Guidelines. In this situation, he or she will request in writing that the Proxy Committee consider voting the proxy other than according to such Guidelines and provide information as the Proxy Committee may request. The Proxy Committee may consider the matter, subject to the conflicts of interest procedures discussed above.

C. Other Proxy Matters

For the following categories, proxies will be voted as stated below:

1. New Proposals. For certain new proposals that are expected to be proposed to shareholders of multiple companies, the Proxy Committee may develop a Voting Guideline which will be incorporated into this Policy.

2. Accounts Adhering to Taft Hartley Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to Taft Hartley principles will be voted according to the Taft Hartley Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor.

3. Accounts Adhering to Socially Responsible Principles. All proposals for accounts adhering to socially responsible principles will be voted according to the Socially Responsible Guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client.

4. Proxies of International Issuers. In general, CMA will refrain from voting securities in cases where international issuers impose share blocking restrictions. However, in the exceptional circumstances that CMA determines that it would be appropriate to vote such securities, all proposals for these securities will be voted only on the specific instruction of the Proxy Committee and to the extent practicable in accordance with the Voting Guidelines set forth in this Policy. Additionally, proxies will typically not be voted in markets where powers of attorney are required to be executed in order to vote shares.

5. Proxy Referrals for Passive Index Accounts. Proxy Referrals for a security that is held only within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and not in any other account within CMA, shall be voted according to the guidelines developed by the proxy vendor or as specified by the client. However, if a security is held within a passive index account managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group and within another CMA-managed account (including without limitation an account actively managed by CMA’s Quantitative Strategies Group), all proposals, including Proxy Referrals, will be voted in accordance with the Voting Guidelines, subject to the other provisions of this Policy.

6. Proxy Voting for Securities on Loan. CMA generally votes in cases where shares have been loaned from actively managed Columbia Funds as long as the shares have been recalled in a timely manner. However, CMA generally does not vote shares that have been loaned from passively managed Columbia Index Funds. Other CMA clients may have their own stock loan programs and may or may not recall their shares for proxy voting.

 

B-5


Table of Contents

 

Supervision

Managers and supervisory personnel are responsible for ensuring that their associates understand and follow this policy and any applicable procedures adopted by the business group to implement the policy. The Proxy Committee has ultimate responsibility for the implementation of this Policy.

Escalation

With the exception of conflicts of interest-related matters, issues arising under this policy should be escalated to the Proxy Committee. Issues involving potential or actual conflicts of interest should be promptly communicated to the Columbia Management Conflicts Officer.

Monitoring/Oversight

CRM and/or Corporate Internal Audit Group perform periodic reviews and assessments of various lines of businesses, including a review of Columbia Management’s compliance with the Proxy Voting Policy.

Recordkeeping

CMA will create and maintain records of each investment company’s proxy record for 12-month periods ended June 30th. CMA will compile the following information for each matter relating to a portfolio security considered at any shareholder meeting during the period covered by the annual report and for which CMA was entitled to vote:

 

   

The name of the issuer of the security;

 

   

The exchange ticker symbol of the portfolio security (if symbol is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The Council on Uniform Securities Identification Procedures number for the portfolio security (if number is available through reasonably practicable means);

 

   

The shareholder meeting date;

 

   

A brief identification of the matter voted on;

 

   

Whether the matter was proposed by the issuer or by a security holder;

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote on the matter;

 

   

How the company cast its vote (e.g., for or against proposal, or abstain; for or withhold regarding the election of directors); and

 

   

Whether the company cast its vote for or against management.

Business groups and support partners are responsible for maintaining all records necessary to evidence compliance with this policy. The records must be properly maintained and readily accessible in order to evidence compliance with this policy.

 

B-6


Table of Contents

 

These records include:

 

Document

  

Responsible Party

Proxy Committee Meeting Minutes and Related Materials    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Proxy Vote Recommendation Form and Supporting Materials of Investment Management Personnel Concerning Proxy Decisions and Recommendations (or any other document created by CMA that was material to making a voting decision or that memorializes the basis for the voting decision)    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations
Conflicts of Interest Review Documentation, including Conflicts of Interest Forms    Compliance Risk Management
Client Communications Regarding Proxy Matters    Client Service Group
Copy of Each Applicable Proxy Statement Unless it has been Filed with the SEC and may be Obtained from the SEC’s EDGAR System    Proxy Group in GWIM Investment Operations

Records should be retained for a period of not less than six years plus the current year. Records must be retained in an appropriate office of CM for the first three years.

 

B-7


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX A – CMA’s Proxy Voting Policy

CMA’S VOTING GUIDELINES

A. The Proxy Committee has adopted the following guidelines for voting proxies:

1. Matters Relating to the Board of Directors/Corporate Governance

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals for the election of directors or for an increase or decrease in the number of directors, provided that no more than one-third of the Board of Directors would, presently or at any time during the previous three-year period, be from management.

However, CMA generally will WITHHOLD votes from pertinent director nominees if:

 

  (i) the board as proposed to be constituted would have more than one-third of its members from management;

 

  (ii) the board does not have audit, nominating, and compensation committees composed solely of directors who qualify as being regarded as “independent,” i.e. having no material relationship, directly or indirectly, with the Company, as CMA’s proxy voting agent may determine (subject to the Proxy Committee’s contrary determination of independence or non-independence);

 

  (iii) the nominee, as a member of the audit committee, permitted the company to incur excessive non-audit fees (as defined below regarding other business matters — ratification of the appointment of auditors);

 

  (iv) a director serves on more than six public company boards;

 

  (v) the CEO serves on more than two public company boards other than the company’s board; or

 

  (vi) CMA generally will vote AGAINST Director nominee of a company who is chief executive officer of another company on whose board the company’s chief executive officer sits (i.e. interlocking executives).

One a CASE-BY-CASE basis, CMA may WITHHOLD votes for a director nominee who has failed to observe good corporate governance practices or, through specific corporate action or inaction (e.g. failing to implement policies for which a majority of shareholders has previously cast votes in favor; served voted for the adoption of a poison pill without approval of shareholders), has demonstrated a disregard for the interests of shareholders.

 

   

Proposals requesting that the board audit, compensation and/or nominating committee be composed solely of independent directors. The Audit Committee must satisfy the independence and experience requirements established by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and the New York Stock Exchange, or appropriate local requirements for foreign securities. At least one member of the Audit Committee must qualify as a “financial expert” in accordance with SEC rules.

 

   

Proposals to declassify a board, absent special circumstances that would indicate that shareholder interests are better served by a classified board structure.

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to separate the role of Chairman of the Board and CEO.

 

   

Proposals that grant or restore shareholder ability to remove directors with or without cause.

 

   

Proposals to permit shareholders to elect directors to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that encourage directors to own a minimum amount of company stock.

 

   

Proposals to provide or to restore shareholder appraisal rights.

 

   

Proposals for the company to adopt confidential voting.

 

B-8


Table of Contents

 

CMA will generally vote FOR shareholder proposals calling for majority voting thresholds for director elections unless the company has adopted formal corporate governance principles that present a meaningful alternative to the majority voting standard and/or provides an adequate response to both new nominees as well as incumbent nominees who fail to receive a majority of votes cast.

CMA will generally vote FOR 162(m) bonus plans unless the Proxy Administrator recommends voting against a specific plan, in which case CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to classify boards, absent special circumstances indicating that shareholder interests would be better served by a classified board structure.

 

   

Proposals that give management the ability to alter the size of the board without shareholder approval.

 

   

Proposals that provide directors may be removed only by supermajority vote.

 

   

Proposals which allow more than one vote per share in the election of directors.

 

   

Proposals that provide that only continuing directors may elect replacements to fill board vacancies.

 

   

Proposals that mandate a minimum amount of company stock that directors must own.

 

   

Proposals to limit the tenure of non-management directors.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

In contested elections of directors. Proposals to adopt or eliminate cumulative voting.

 

   

CMA generally will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis on board approved proposals relating to corporate governance. Such proposals include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Reimbursement of proxy solicitation expenses taking into consideration whether or not CMA was in favor of the dissidents.

 

   

Proxy contest advance notice. CMA generally will vote FOR proposals that allow shareholders to submit proposals as close to the meeting date as possible while allowing for sufficient time for Company response, SEC review, and analysis by other shareholders.

 

   

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis to indemnify directors and officers, and AGAINST proposals to indemnify external auditors.

 

   

CMA will vote FOR the indemnification of internal auditors, unless the costs associated with the approval are not disclosed.

2. Compensation

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

CMA generally will vote FOR management sponsored compensation plans (such as bonus plans, incentive plans, stock option plans, pension and retirement benefits, stock purchase plans or thrift plans) if they are consistent with industry and country standards.

 

   

Proposals requiring that executive severance arrangements be submitted for shareholder ratification.

 

   

Proposals asking a company to expense stock options.

 

   

Proposals to put option repricings to a shareholder vote.

 

   

Employee stock purchase plans that have the following features: (i) the shares purchased under the plan are acquired for no less than 85% of their market value, (ii) the offering period under the plan is 27 months or less, and (iii) dilution is 10% or less.

 

B-9


Table of Contents

 

   

Shareholder proposals to adopt a non-binding advisory vote on Executive Compensation (“Say on Pay”).

 

   

CMA recognizes that individual compensation committees are in the best position to determine the optimal design of share based plans. However, CMA generally prefers a greater use of restricted stock in place of stock options due to the greater uncertainty involved with the valuation of stock options at the time of issue.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Stock option plans that permit issuance of options with an exercise price below the stock’s current market price, or that permit replacing or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals to authorize the replacement or repricing of out-of-the money options.

 

   

Proposals requesting that plan administrators have advance authority to amend the terms of a plan without detailed disclosure of the specific amendments. When sufficient details are provided on the amendments permitted by the advance authority, CMA will recommend on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

CMA generally is opposed to compensation plans that substantially dilute ownership interest in a company, provide participants with excessive awards, or have objectionable structural features. Specifically, for equity-based plans, if the proposed number of shares authorized for option programs (excluding authorized shares for expired options) exceeds 5% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years, or exceeds 1% of the average number of shares outstanding for the last 3 years (for directors only), CMA will vote on such proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis. CMA requires that management provide substantial justification for the repricing of options.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals regarding approval of specific executive severance arrangements.

 

   

-Management proposals regarding “Say on Pay” (i.e. non-binding advisory vote on pay).

 

   

Proposals that involve awarding 50% or more of the equity shares of an equity-based compensation plan to the top five or fewer executives.

3. Capitalization

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to increase the authorized shares for stock dividends, stock splits (and reverse stock splits) or general issuance, unless proposed as an anti-takeover measure or a general issuance proposal increases the authorization by more than 30% without a clear need presented by the company. Proposals for reverse stock splits should include an overall reduction in authorization.

For companies recognizing preemptive rights for existing shareholders, CMA generally will vote FOR general issuance proposals that increase the authorized shares by more than 30%. CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis all such proposals by companies that do not recognize preemptive rights for existing shareholders.

 

   

Proposals for the elimination of authorized but unissued shares or retirement of those shares purchased for sinking fund or treasury stock.

 

   

Proposals to institute/renew open market share repurchase plans in which all shareholders may participate on equal terms.

 

   

Proposals to reduce or change the par value of common stock, provided the number of shares is also changed in order to keep the capital unchanged.

 

B-10


Table of Contents

 

CMA will evaluate on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals regarding:

 

   

Management proposals that allow listed companies to de-list and terminate the registration of their common stock. CMA will determine whether the transaction enhances shareholder value by giving consideration to:

 

   

Whether the company has attained benefits from being publicly traded.

 

   

Cash-out value

 

   

Balanced interests of continuing vs. cashed-out shareholders

 

   

Market reaction to public announcement of transaction

4. Mergers, Restructurings and Other Transactions

CMA will review, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, business transactions such as mergers, acquisitions, reorganizations, liquidations, spinoffs, buyouts and sale of all or substantially all of a company’s assets.

5. Anti-Takeover Measures

CMA generally will vote AGAINST proposals intended largely to avoid acquisition prior to the occurrence of an actual event or to discourage acquisition by creating a cost constraint. With respect to the following measures, CMA generally will vote as follows:

Poison Pills

 

   

CMA votes FOR shareholder proposals that ask a company to submit its poison pill for shareholder ratification.

 

   

CMA generally votes FOR shareholder proposals to eliminate a poison pill.

 

   

CMA generally votes AGAINST management proposals to ratify a poison pill.

 

Greenmail

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to adopt anti-greenmail charter or bylaw amendments or to otherwise restrict a company’s ability to make greenmail payments.

Supermajority vote

 

   

CMA will vote AGAINST board-approved proposals to adopt anti-takeover measures such as supermajority voting provisions, issuance of blank check preferred stock, the creation of a separate class of stock with disparate voting rights and charter amendments adopting control share acquisition provisions.

Control Share Acquisition Provisions

 

   

CMA will vote FOR proposals to opt out of control share acquisition statutes.

6. Other Business Matters

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Bylaw amendments giving holders of at least 25% of outstanding common stock the ability to call a special meeting of stockholders.

 

   

Board governance document amendments or other proposals which give the lead independent director the authority to call special meetings of the independent directors at any time.

 

B-11


Table of Contents

 

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals to approve routine business matters such as changing the company’s name and procedural matters relating to the shareholder meeting such as approving the minutes of a prior meeting.

 

   

Proposals to ratify the appointment of auditors, unless any of the following apply in which case CMA will generally vote AGAINST the proposal:

 

   

Credible reason exists to question:

 

   

The auditor’s independence, as determined by applicable regulatory requirements.

 

   

The accuracy or reliability of the auditor’s opinion as to the company’s financial position.

 

   

Fees paid to the auditor or its affiliates for “non-audit” services exceeds 25% of the total fees paid for “audit,” “audit-related” and “tax compliance” and/or “tax return preparation” services, as disclosed in the company’s proxy materials.

 

   

Bylaw or charter changes that are of a housekeeping nature (e.g., updates or corrections).

 

   

Proposals to approve the annual reports and accounts provided the certifications required by the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 have been provided.

CMA generally will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals to eliminate the right of shareholders to act by written consent or call special meetings.

 

   

Proposals providing management with authority to adjourn an annual or special shareholder meeting absent compelling reasons, or to adopt, amend or repeal bylaws without shareholder approval, or to vote unmarked proxies in favor of management.

 

   

Shareholder proposals to change the date, time or location of the company’s annual meeting of shareholders.

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Authorization to transact other unidentified substantive (as opposed to procedural) business at a meeting.

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis:

 

   

Proposals to change the location of the company’s state of incorporation. CMA considers whether financial benefits (e.g., reduced fees or taxes) likely to accrue to the company as a result of a reincorporation or other change of domicile outweigh any accompanying material diminution of shareholder rights.

 

   

Proposals on whether and how to vote on “bundled” or otherwise conditioned proposals, depending on the overall economic effects upon shareholders.

CMA generally will ABSTAIN from voting on shareholder proposals predominantly involving social, socio-economic, environmental, political or other similar matters on the basis that their impact on share value can rarely be anticipated with any high degree of confidence. CMA may, on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, vote:

 

   

FOR proposals seeking inquiry and reporting with respect to, rather than cessation or affirmative implementation of, specific policies where the pertinent issue warrants separate communication to shareholders; and

 

   

FOR or AGAINST the latter sort of proposal in light of the relative benefits and detriments (e.g. distraction, costs, other burdens) to share value which may be expected to flow from passage of the proposal.

 

B-12


Table of Contents

 

7. Other Matters Relating to Foreign Issues

CMA generally will vote FOR:

 

   

Most stock (scrip) dividend proposals. CMA votes AGAINST proposals that do not allow for a cash option unless management demonstrates that the cash option is harmful to shareholder value.

 

   

Proposals to capitalize the company’s reserves for bonus issues of shares or to increase the par value of shares.

 

   

Proposals to approve control and profit transfer agreements between a parent and its subsidiaries.

 

   

Management proposals seeking the discharge of management and supervisory board members, unless there is concern about the past actions of the company’s auditors/directors and/or legal action is being taken against the board by other shareholders.

 

   

Management proposals concerning allocation of income and the distribution of dividends, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

 

   

Proposals for the adoption of financing plans if they are in the best economic interests of shareholders.

CMA will generally vote FOR proposals to approve Directors’ Fees, unless the proxy vendor would vote against such proposal in accordance with its guidelines, in which case CMA will evaluate the proposal on a CASE-BY-CASE basis.

CMA will evaluate management proposals to approve protective preference shares for Netherlands located company-friendly foundations proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis and will only support resolutions if:

 

   

The supervisory board needs to approve an issuance of shares while the supervisory board is independent within the meaning of CMA’s categorization rules and the Dutch Corporate Governance Code.

 

   

No call/put option agreement exists between the company and the foundation.

 

   

There is a qualifying offer clause or there are annual management and supervisory board elections.

 

   

The issuance authority is for a maximum of 18 months.

 

   

The board of the company-friendly foundation is independent.

 

   

The company has disclosed under what circumstances it expects to make use of the possibility to issue preference shares.

 

   

There are no priority shares or other egregious protective or entrenchment tools.

 

   

The company releases its proxy circular, with details of the poison pill proposal, at least three weeks prior to the meeting.

 

   

Art 2:359c Civil Code of the legislative proposal has been implemented.

8. Investment Company Matters

Election of Directors:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the election of directors, considering the following factors:

 

   

Board structure

 

   

Attendance at board and committee meetings.

 

B-13


Table of Contents

 

CMA will WITHHOLD votes from directors who:

 

   

Attend less than 75 percent of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse for the absences. Valid reasons include illness or absence due to company business. Participation via telephone is acceptable. In addition, if the director missed only one meeting or one day’s meetings, votes should not be withheld even if such absence dropped the director’s attendance below 75 percent.

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal that is approved by a majority of shares outstanding;

 

   

Ignore a shareholder proposal this is approved by a majority of the votes cast for two consecutive years;

 

   

Are interested directors and sit on the audit or nominating committee; or

 

   

Are interested directors and the full board serves as the audit or nominating committee or the company does not have one of these committees.

Proxy Contests:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for proxy contests, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance relative to its peers

 

   

Market in which fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the pertinent issues (e.g., closed-end fund share market value discount to NAV)

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity and votes on related proposals

 

   

Strategy of the incumbents versus the dissidents

 

   

Independence of incumbent directors; director nominees

 

   

Experience and skills of director nominees

 

   

Governance profile of the company

 

   

Evidence of management entrenchment

Converting Closed-end Fund to Open-end Fund:

CMA will vote conversion proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Past performance as a closed-end fund

 

   

Market in which the fund invests

 

   

Measures taken by the board to address the discount

 

   

Past shareholder activism, board activity, and votes on related proposals.

Investment Advisory Agreements:

CMA will vote investment advisory agreements on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Proposed and current fee schedules

 

   

Fund category/investment objective

 

   

Performance benchmarks

 

   

Share price performance as compared with peers

 

   

Resulting fees relative to peers

 

   

Assignments (where the adviser undergoes a change of control)

 

B-14


Table of Contents

 

Approving New Classes or Series of Shares:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of new classes or series of shares.

Preferred Stock Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals for the authorization for or increase in the preferred shares, considering the following factors:

 

   

Stated specific financing purpose

 

   

Possible dilution for common shares

 

   

Whether the shares can be used for anti-takeover purposes

Policies Addressed by the Investment Company Act of 1940 (“1940 Act”):

CMA will vote proposals regarding adoption or changes of policies addressed by the 1940 Act on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Regulatory developments

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Current and potential risk

CMA generally will vote FOR these amendments as long as the proposed changes do not fundamentally alter the investment focus of the fund and do comply with current SEC interpretations.

Changing a Fundamental Restriction to a Non-fundamental Restriction:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fundamental restriction to a non-fundamental restriction, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fund’s target investments

 

   

Reasons given by the fund for the change

 

   

Projected impact of the change on the portfolio

Change Fundamental Investment Objective to Non-fundamental:

CMA will vote AGAINST proposals to change a fund’s investment objective from fundamental to non-fundamental unless management acknowledges meaningful limitations upon its future requested ability to change the objective

Name Change Proposals:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s name, considering the following factors:

 

   

Political/economic changes in the target market

 

   

Consolidation in the target market

 

   

Current asset composition

 

B-15


Table of Contents

 

Change in Fund’s Subclassification:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change a fund’s subclassification, considering the following factors:

 

   

Potential competitiveness

 

   

Current and potential returns

 

   

Risk of concentration

 

   

Consolidation in target industry

Disposition of Assets/Termination/Liquidation:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis these proposals, considering the following factors:

 

   

Strategies employed to salvage the company

 

   

Past performance of the fund

 

   

Terms of the liquidation

Changes to the Charter Document:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to change the charter document, considering the following factors:

 

   

The degree of change implied by the proposal

 

   

The efficiencies that could result

 

   

The state of incorporation; net effect on shareholder rights

 

   

Regulatory standards and implications

CMA will vote FOR:

 

   

Proposals allowing the Board to impose, without shareholder approval, fees payable upon redemption of fund shares, provided imposition of such fees is likely to benefit long-term fund investors (e.g., by deterring market timing activity by other fund investors)

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to amend, without shareholder approval, the fund’s management agreement(s) with its investment adviser(s) or sub-advisers, provided the amendment is not required by applicable law (including the Investment Company Act of 1940) or interpretations thereunder to require such approval

CMA will vote AGAINST:

 

   

Proposals enabling the Board to:

 

   

Change, without shareholder approval the domicile of the fund

 

   

Adopt, without shareholder approval, material amendments of the fund’s declaration of trust or other organizational document

Changing the Domicile of a Fund:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reincorporate, considering the following factors:

 

   

Regulations of both states

 

   

Required fundamental policies of both states

 

   

The increased flexibility available

 

B-16


Table of Contents

 

Authorizing the Board to Hire and Terminate Subadvisors Without Shareholder Approval:

CMA will vote FOR proposals to enable the Board or Investment Adviser to hire and terminate sub-advisers, without shareholder approval, in accordance with applicable rules or exemptive orders under the Investment Company Act of 1940

Distribution Agreements:

CMA will vote these proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Fees charged to comparably sized funds with similar objectives

 

   

The proposed distributor’s reputation and past performance

 

   

The competitiveness of the fund in the industry

 

   

Terms of the agreement

Master-Feeder Structure:

CMA will vote FOR the establishment of a master-feeder structure.

Mergers:

CMA will vote merger proposals on a CASE-BY-CASE basis, considering the following factors:

 

   

Resulting fee structure

 

   

Performance of both funds

 

   

Continuity of management personnel

 

   

Changes in corporate governance and their impact on shareholder rights

Shareholder Proposals to Establish Director Ownership Requirement:

CMA will generally vote AGAINST shareholder proposals that mandate a specific minimum amount of stock that directors must own in order to qualify as a director or to remain on the board. While CMA favors stockownership on the part of directors, the company should determine the appropriate ownership requirement.

Shareholder Proposals to Reimburse Shareholder for Expenses Incurred:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to reimburse proxy solicitation expenses.

Shareholder Proposals to Terminate the Investment Adviser:

CMA will vote on a CASE-BY-CASE basis proposals to terminate the investment adviser, considering the following factors:

 

   

Performance of the fund’s NAV

 

   

The fund’s history of shareholder relations

 

   

The performance of other funds under the adviser’s management

 

B-17


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX B

Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form

Conflict Review Questionnaire for Proxy Voting Working Group Members and Other Individuals

Participating in the Proxy Voting Decision-Making Process.

Instructions: Please complete each of the questions. Please provide an explanation for any affirmative responses. Return the completed questionnaire to Columbia Management Conflicts of Interest Officer.

 

 

 

Issuer and Proxy Matter:      

 

 

 

 

  1. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any management personnel of the issuer1?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  2. Do you or any member of your immediate family have an existing (or potential) business, financial, personal or other relationship with any person participating, supporting, opposing or otherwise connected with the particular proxy proposal (e.g., principals of the issuer; director nominees of issuer company; shareholder activists)?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

  3. Have you discussed this particular proxy proposal with anyone outside of Columbia Management’s investment group2?

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

 

  4. Are you aware of any other potential personal conflicts of interest not described above? Please detail below.

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

    ___________________________________________________________________________________

 

Name:      
Signed:      
Date:      

 

1 Personal investing in the issuer by you or a member of your immediate family does not require an affirmative response to this item.
2 Communications with issuer or solicitors in the regular course of business would not have to be disclosed on this form.

 

B-18


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C

CMA Proxy Vote Recommendation/Proxy Committee Request Form

 

Name of Investment Associate:      

 

Company Name:      

 

Overview of Proxy Vote and Meeting Date:      

 

 

 

Proxy Agenda Item(s)

 

Description of Item:      
 
(The above information will be pre-populated by the Proxy Department.)

 

Recommendation (FOR, AGAINST, ABSTAIN) including brief rationale:      

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Please attach any supporting information other than analysis or reports provided by the Proxy Department.

 

 

 

Signed

By signing, I am certifying that I either have no conflicts of interest-related information to report or have sent a completed “Conflicts of Interest Disclosure and Certification Form” to Compliance Risk Management (Conflicts Officer).

 

 

Send Completed Forms to:

GWIM Investment Operations – Proxy Department

        or

In the case of Proxy Votes to be referred to the Proxy Committee, submit this form and materials to the Chair of the Proxy Committee

 

B-19


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX C — SALES CHARGE WAIVERS

Front-End Sales Charge Waivers

In addition to the eligible investors described in the prospectuses, the investors listed below can buy Class A shares, Class E shares or Class T shares, without paying a front-end sales charge:

 

   

Employees of Bank of America, its affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

   

Employees or partners of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Marsico Capital Management, LLC (or their successors).

 

   

Individuals receiving a distribution from a Bank of America trust, fiduciary, custodial or other similar account may use the proceeds of that distribution to buy Class A shares without paying a front-end sales charge, as long as the proceeds are invested in the funds within 90 days of the date of distribution.

 

   

Any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time has remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases where a Columbia Fund Class Z share is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date that those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

Class I shares are only available to the Funds and are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the Fund’s prospectus. Class R, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge.

Investors can also buy Class A shares without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale from any Columbia Fund Class A, B, C or T shares within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds. In addition, shareholders of the money market fund series of BofA Funds Series Trust, which were formerly referred to as the Columbia Money Market Funds (the Former Columbia Money Market Funds), can also buy Class A shares of the Columbia Funds without paying a sales charge if the purchase is made from the proceeds of a sale of shares from a Former Columbia Money Market Fund within 90 days, up to the amount of the sales proceeds, provided that the proceeds are from the sale of shares of a Former Columbia Money Market Fund purchased on or before April 30, 2010. To be eligible for these reinstatement privileges the purchase must be made into an account for the same owner, but does not need to be into the same Columbia Fund from which the shares were sold. The Transfer Agent, Distributor or their agents must receive a written reinstatement request within 90 days after the shares are sold and the purchase of Class A shares through this reinstatement privilege will be made at the NAV of such shares next calculated after the request is received in good order.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. Unless you provide your financial advisor with information in writing about all of the factors that may count toward a waiver of the sales charge, there can be no assurance that you will receive all of the waivers for which you may be eligible. You should request that your financial advisor provide this information to the Fund when placing your purchase order. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible investors, please see the prospectuses.

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Waivers (Class A, Class B, Class C and Class T Shares)

In addition to the redemptions eligible for CDSC waivers described in the prospectuses, shareholders won’t pay a CDSC in the following circumstances:

Disability: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

Health savings accounts: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by Bank of America affiliates.*

Medical payments: For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on (i) shares sold for medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) distributions made to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

Systematic Withdrawal Plan (SWP): For shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on sales occurring pursuant to a SWP established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on SWP sales until this requirement is met.

Qualified retirement plans: CDSCs may be waived on shares (except for Class B shares) sold by certain group retirement plans held in omnibus accounts. However, CDSC may not be waived for Class C shares if the waiver would occur as a result of a plan-level termination.

Redemptions under certain retirement plans and accounts: CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2 for shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010.**

Loans from qualified retirement plans: For Class B shares, and for Class A and Class C shares purchased prior to September 7, 2010, CDSCs may be waived on shares sold in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the Fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the Fund or the Transfer Agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

 

C-2


Table of Contents

 

Class I shares, Class R shares, Class R4 shares, Class R5 shares and Class W shares are sold without a CDSC.

Restrictions may apply to certain accounts and certain transactions. The Distributor may, in its sole discretion, authorize the waiver of the CDSC for additional classes of investors. The Fund may change or cancel these terms at any time. Any change or cancellation applies only to future purchases. For more information about the sales charge reductions and waivers described here, as well as additional categories of eligible redemptions, please see the prospectuses.

 

C-3


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX D — DESCRIPTION OF STATE RISK FACTORS

State Tax Exempt Funds

The state tax-exempt Funds invest primarily in municipal securities issued by a single state and political sub-divisions of that state. Each Fund will be particularly affected by political and economic conditions and developments in the state in which it invests. This vulnerability to factors affecting the state’s tax-exempt investments will be significantly greater than that of more geographically diversified funds, and may result in greater losses and volatility. Because of the relatively small number of issuers of tax-exempt securities, the Fund may invest a higher percentage of assets in a single issuer and, therefore, be more exposed to the risk of loss than a fund that invests more broadly. At times, the Fund and other accounts managed by the Adviser may own all or most of the debt of a particular issuer. This concentration of ownership may make it more difficult to sell, or to determine the fair value of, these investments. In addition, a Fund may focus on a segment of the tax-exempt debt market, such as revenue bonds for health care facilities, housing or airports. These investments may cause the value of a Fund’s shares to change more than the values of shares of funds that invest more diversely. The yields on the securities in which the Funds invest generally are dependent on a variety of factors, including the financial condition of the issuer or other obligor, the revenue source from which the debt service is payable, general economic and monetary conditions, conditions in the relevant market, the size of a particular issue, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. In addition to such factors, geographically concentrated securities will experience particular sensitivity to local conditions, including political and economic changes, adverse conditions to an industry significant to the area, and other developments within a particular locality. Because many tax-exempt bonds may be revenue or general obligations of local governments or authorities, ratings on tax-exempt bonds may be different from the ratings given to the general obligation bonds of a particular state.

Certain events may adversely affect all investments within a particular market segment of the market. Examples include litigation, legislation or court decisions, concerns about pending or contemplated litigation, legislation or court decisions, or lower demand for the services or products provided by a particular market segment. Investing mostly in state-specific, tax-exempt investments makes the Funds more vulnerable to the relevant state’s economy and to factors affecting tax-exempt issuers in the state than would be true for more geographically diversified funds. These risks include, among others:

 

   

the inability or perceived inability of a government authority to collect sufficient tax or other revenues to meet its payment obligations;

 

   

natural disasters and ecological or environmental concerns;

 

   

the introduction of constitutional or statutory limits on a tax-exempt issuer’s ability to raise revenues or increase taxes;

 

   

the inability of an issuer to pay interest on or to repay principal or securities in which the funds invest during recessionary periods; and

 

   

economic or demographic factors that may cause a decrease in tax or other revenues for a government authority or for private operators of publicly financed facilities.

More information about state specific risks may be available from official state resources.

State Specific Information

Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund’s investments are highly dependent on and sensitive to the general fiscal and economic stability of the State of Connecticut (“Connecticut” or the “State”), as well as the general fiscal and economic stability of Connecticut’s subdivisions, agencies, instrumentalities or authorities, which issue the securities in which the Fund invests. The following information supplements information set forth in Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund’s prospectus, constitutes only a brief summary and does not purport to be a complete description of certain state-specific considerations and is provided to investors in view of Connecticut

 

D-1


Table of Contents

Tax-Exempt Fund’s policy of concentrating its investments in securities issued by issuers of a single state. The information is based on publicly available sources and has not been independently verified by the Adviser. It is expected that the information will be updated only on an annual basis and thus may be out of date at any time that you make an investment decision to purchase or sell shares of Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund.

To the extent that any statements made below involve matters of forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates, whether or not expressly stated to be such, they are made as such and not as representations of fact or certainty, and no representation is made that any of these statements has been or will be realized. All forecasts, projections, assumptions, opinions or estimates are “forward looking statements” that must be read with an abundance of caution and that may not be realized or may not occur in the future.

Connecticut

The following information relates specifically to Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund. This summary does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all relevant facts for the Fund. Although the Fund has no reason to believe that the information summarized below is not correct in all material respects, such information has not been independently verified for accuracy or thoroughness. Rather, this information has been obtained from official statements, prospectuses and other disclosure provided in connection with various securities offerings of Connecticut and local agencies in Connecticut available as of the date of this Statement of Additional Information. The Fund assumes that all such material was prepared and published in a manner consistent with current standards of disclosure. Further, estimates and projections contained in the following information should not be construed as statements of fact. They are based on assumptions that may be affected by numerous factors and there can be no assurance that such estimates and projections will be realized or achieved.

The Fund is more susceptible to factors adversely affecting issuers of Connecticut municipal securities than comparable municipal bond funds that do not focus on investments in Connecticut issuers.

Introduction. The State, together with the nation as a whole, is facing economic and fiscal challenges brought on by the current recession. These challenges for the State include fiscal year deficits and falling employment, among other issues. The State Office of Policy and Management monitors such matters and generally issues a report periodically estimating the current fiscal year deficit. The State Comptroller issues a similar report periodically. From time to time the legislature’s Office of Fiscal Analysis also issues reports covering these matters. The most current such information is described below under “State General Fund,” which should be considered together with the other information set forth herein.

The State’s current and projected fiscal and economic condition, as described herein, is subject to change based on a number of factors. Such factors include, but are not limited to: (a) developments with respect to the national economy as a whole, (b) developments with respect to the financial services sector of the economy, (c) developments in the world economy, and in particular commodity prices such as oil, (d) federal fiscal and economic policies, including fiscal stimulus efforts in general and the effect of such stimulus efforts in the State and the amount of federal aid to the State, (e) the extent to which the federal stimulus legislation, and in particular The American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (the “ARRA”), as enacted and implemented, provides less federal aid to the State than was anticipated in the adopted biennial budget, and the resulting need to implement other revenue enhancements or expenditure reductions, and (f) the effect of the State’s constitutional balanced budget requirement and spending cap provisions on the adoption of the biennial budget and the effect spending constraints might have on the State’s economy. Such factors are continually changing, and no assurances can be given with respect to how such factors or other factors will materialize in the future or what effect they will have on the State’s fiscal and economic condition.

Connecticut’s economic performance is measured by personal income, which has been among the highest in the nation, and gross state product (the market value of all final goods and services produced by labor and

 

D-2


Table of Contents

property located within the State), which demonstrated slower growth in the early 2000s, but expanded at a healthy pace in 2004, surpassing the New England and national growth rates. Since then, Connecticut’s annual growth in gross state product has performed better than the New England region, but mostly slower than the nation. Employment had gained approximately 66,800 jobs by late 2007 since it bottomed out in July of 2003, but in 2008 Connecticut lost jobs.

After enjoying an extraordinary boom during the late 1990s, Connecticut, as well as the rest of the northeast and the nation, experienced an economic slowdown during the recession of the early 2000s. The unemployment rate in the State reached its low of 2.3% in 2000, compared to New England’s average of 2.8% and the national average of 4.0%. After climbing to a high of 5.5% in 2003, Connecticut’s unemployment rate declined to 4.4% for 2006. The current recession brought the unemployment rate up to 5.1% for the first six months of 2008, compared to the New England average of 4.8% and the national average of 5.1% for the same period.

General Fund. The State finances most of its operations through its General Fund. However, certain State functions, such as the State’s transportation budget, are financed through other State funds. General Fund revenues are derived primarily from the collection of State taxes, including the personal income tax, the sales and use tax and the corporation business tax. Miscellaneous fees, receipts, transfers and unrestricted federal grants account for most of the other General Fund revenue. The State, as of the forecast date, expected to derive approximately 76 percent and 72 percent, respectively, of its General Fund revenues from taxes during the 2007-08 fiscal year and the 2008-09 fiscal year.

Budget for Fiscal Years 2007-2008 and 2008-2009. Although the General Assembly did not pass the biennial budget for fiscal years 2007-08 and 2008-09 prior to its adjournment date of June 6, 2007, in a subsequent special session, the General Assembly passed, and the Governor signed into law on June 26, 2007, the biennial budget for fiscal years 2007-08 and 2008-09. The budget for fiscal year 2007-08 included General Fund revenues of $16,315.6 million and net appropriations of $16,314.9 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.7 million The budget for fiscal year 2008-09 included General Fund revenues of $17,073.1 million and net appropriations of $17,072.3 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.8 million. Pursuant to Public Act No. 07-1 of the September Special Session of the General Assembly, the General Assembly made an additional appropriation of $0.7 million for clean contracting standards, thereby reducing the projected General Fund surplus for the 2008-09 fiscal year to $0.1 million.

The General Assembly also included in the biennial budget (i) the appropriation of $613.7 million of the anticipated fiscal year 2006-07 General Fund surplus funds to pay for various spending items, including $300 million to fund a portion of the State’s contribution to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund and $85 million for debt retirement, (ii) a reduction of lapses in the amount of $96.6 million and (iii) a transfer of $80 million of the anticipated fiscal year 2006-07 General Fund surplus to the budget for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2009, resulting in a net reduction in the anticipated 2006-07 surplus of $790.3 million. According to estimates of the Office of Fiscal Analysis, approximately $471.9 million of the appropriations were for one-time purposes and approximately $318.4 million of the appropriations were for on-going purposes.

The budget was $690.4 million above the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2007-08 and $28.2 million below the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2008-09. In accordance with the provisions of Article XXVIII of the Amendments to the Constitution, the Governor issued a declaration to exceed the State’s expenditure cap in fiscal year 2007-08. This declaration was ratified by a three-fifths vote of each house of the General Assembly.

Fiscal Year 2007-2008 Operations. Pursuant to the Comptroller’s financial statements provided on December 31, 2008, as of June 30, 2008, General Fund revenues were $16,418.8 million, General Fund expenditures and net miscellaneous adjustments were $16,319.4 million and the General Fund balance for the 2007-08 fiscal year was a surplus of $99.4 million The entire surplus was reserved for fiscal year 2008-09 spending.

 

D-3


Table of Contents

 

Governor’s Proposed Midterm Budget Adjustments. Per Section 4-71 of the Connecticut General Statutes, the Governor is required to submit a status report to the General Assembly on the biennial budget enacted in the previous year. The status report must include any recommendations for adjustments and revisions to the enacted budget.

On February 6, 2008 the Governor submitted to the General Assembly a status report including detailed projections of expenditures and revenues and proposed Midterm Budget Adjustments for the 2007-08 and 2008-09 fiscal years. The General Assembly convened on February 6, 2008 to consider the Governor’s proposed Midterm Budget Adjustments and adjourned on May 7, 2008. The legislature did not make any midterm budget adjustments for the 2008-09 fiscal year in the legislative session which ended May 7, 2008. However, in subsequent special sessions, $79 million was appropriated for energy relief programs in fiscal year 2008-09 and the 2007-08 surplus of $83.4 million, plus the transfer of $16 million pursuant to Section 91 of Public Act No. 07-1 of the June Special Session, was transferred for use in fiscal year 2008-09. In addition, the scheduled increase on July 1, 2008 in the oil companies tax from 7.0% to 7.5% was eliminated.

Fiscal Year 2008-2009 Operations. Pursuant to Section 4-66 of the Connecticut General Statutes, the Office of Policy and Management provides estimates to the Comptroller by the twentieth day of each month of revenues and expenditures for the current fiscal year for use by the Comptroller in preparing the Comptroller’s monthly report. In the monthly estimates provided by the Office of Policy and Management on August 20, 2008 (as of the period ending July 31, 2008), September 22, 2008 (as of the period ending August 31, 2008), October 20, 2008 (as of the period ending September 30, 2008), November 20, 2008 (as of the period ending October 31, 2008) and December 20, 2008 (as of the period ending November 30, 2008), each for the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year, the General Fund was estimated to have a deficit of $145.7 million, $302.4 million, $107.9 million, $356.3 million and $193.0 million, respectively. In the monthly estimate provided by the Office of Policy and Management on January 20, 2009 for the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year, as of the period ending December 31, 2008, General Fund revenues were estimated at $16,098.0 million, General Fund expenditures and miscellaneous adjustments were estimated at $17,019.7 million and the General Fund was estimated to have a deficit of $921.7 million These revenue estimates include an estimated $40 million from tax amnesty program and $12 million from the escheat of unclaimed bottler deposits and transfers totaling $71.2 million from various funds to the General Fund per Public Act No. 08-1 of the November 24, Special Session and Public Act No. 09-1. The expenditure estimates included three allotment rescissions in 2008 totaling $157 million and two mitigation plans totaling $69.8 million per Public Act No. 08-1 of the November 24, 2008 Special Session and Public Act No. 09-1. The revenue estimates as of December 31, 2008 did not take into account any economic effect as a result of the changes in the financial and credit markets occurring after December 31, 2008 or during the remainder of the fiscal year. No assurances can be given that future report estimates will match the Office of Policy and Management’s prior estimates.

By statute, the State’s fiscal position is reported monthly by the Comptroller. In her monthly reports dated September 2, 2008, October 1, 2008 and November 3, 2008, the Comptroller generally agreed with the Office of Policy and Management’s projections as of the periods ending July 31, 2008, August 31, 2008 and September 30, 2008, respectively. In her monthly report dated December 1, 2008, the Comptroller’s estimate of the General Fund deficit for the 2008-09 fiscal year was $50 million higher than the Office of Policy and Management’s projection for the same period. In her monthly report dated January 2, 2009, the Comptroller’s estimate of the General Fund deficit for the 2008-09 fiscal year was $150 million higher than the Office of Policy and Management’s projections for the same period. In her monthly report dated February 2, 2009 for the period ending December 31, 2008, the Comptroller’s estimate of the General Fund deficit for the 2008-09 fiscal year was $1.1 billion, which amount was $172.9 million higher than the estimate of the Office of Policy and Management.

Pursuant to Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes, whenever the cumulative monthly financial statement issued by the Comptroller indicates a projected General Fund deficit greater than one percent of the total General Fund appropriations, the Governor is required within thirty days to file a report with the joint

 

D-4


Table of Contents

standing committees of the General Assembly on appropriations and on finance, revenue and bonding. The report must include a plan which the Governor must implement to modify agency allotments to the extent necessary to prevent a deficit. Should such plan result in a reduction of more than five percent of total appropriations, approval of the General Assembly would be required. Since July 2008, the Governor has exercised her authority under Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes in rescinding allotments totaling $157 million in General Fund expenditures. In addition, the Governor has proposed two deficit mitigation packages to address the then projected deficits that exceeded her allotment rescission authority. Public Act No. 08-1 of the November 24, 2008 Special Session and Public Act No. 09-1 were enacted by the General Assembly and resulted in an estimated $193.6 million in deficit mitigation. Even with these changes, on January 20, 2009, the Office of Policy and Management projected a $921.7 million deficit in the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year.

The above projections are only estimates and the information in the monthly letters of the Office of Policy and Management to the Comptroller and in the Comptroller’s monthly reports contain only estimates and no assurances can be given that future events will materialize as estimated or that subsequent estimates, adjustments or audit or actions of the General Assembly will not indicate changes in the final result of the fiscal year 2008-09 operations of the General Fund.

Pursuant to the Comptroller’s unaudited preliminary financial results dated September 1, 2009, the Comptroller estimated the General Fund revenues for the 2008-09 fiscal year were $15,700.8 million, General Fund expenditures and miscellaneous adjustments were $16,626.7 million and the General Fund balance for the 2008-09 fiscal year was estimated to have a deficit of $925.9 million. The Comptroller indicated in her letter that under House Bill No. 6802, the General Assembly approved additional carry forward authority which is accounted for as part of the 2008-09 fiscal year deficit and therefore increases the deficit. Accordingly, the 2008-09 fiscal year deficit would increase to $947.6 million upon the act becoming law. House Bill No. 6802 became law after the date of the Comptroller’s September 1, 2009 results. Pursuant to Public Act No. 09-2 of the June Special Session, for the purpose of funding the deficit in the General Fund for the 2008-09 fiscal year, the Treasurer is authorized to issue notes of the State in an amount not to exceed the amount of such deficit and in such additional amounts as the Treasurer shall determine to pay the costs of issuance of any such notes and interest payable or accrued on such notes through June 30, 2011.

The above projections are only estimates and the information in the Comptroller’s report contains only estimates and no assurances can be given that future events will materialize as estimated or that subsequent estimates, adjustments or audit or actions of the General Assembly will not indicate changes in the final result of the fiscal year 2008-09 operations of the General Fund.

Budget for Fiscal Years 2009-2010 and 2010-2011. On June 3, 2009, the General Assembly adjourned its regular 2009 session without adopting a fiscal 2009-2011 biennial budget. Prior to adjournment, the General Assembly passed resolutions calling for a special session to take up matters related to adoption of a budget. The special session was immediately convened at the conclusion of the regular session. During the special session, the General Assembly passed a General Fund budget for the 2009-10 and 2010-11 fiscal years which was subsequently vetoed by the Governor.

The State continued to run its operations pursuant to executive orders issued by the Governor. Authorization to pay debt service on the State’s general obligation bonds remained unaffected. The executive orders directed all department heads and executive branch employees to limit purchases of goods and services and directed all department heads to utilize personnel and other resources in an effective and efficient manner, giving priority to programs that provide direct care services, administer justice and protect the public health and safety. The executive orders covered the months of July, August and the portion of September until the approval of an appropriation act for the fiscal year commencing July 1, 2009.

In a special session, the General Assembly passed the biennial budget for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 which subsequently became law on September 8, 2009. The enacted budget, Public Act No. 09-3 of June 2009

 

D-5


Table of Contents

Special Session, for fiscal year 2009-10 included General Fund revenues of $17,375.4 million and net appropriations of $17,374.6 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.8 million. The budget for fiscal year 2010-11 included General Fund revenues of $17,591.9 million and net appropriations of $17,591.0 million, resulting in a projected surplus of $0.9 million.

The enacted biennial budget raises net revenues from three major resources: 1) grants from the ARRA, 2) transfers from other State funds to the State’s General Fund and securitizations, and 3) net increases in taxes and miscellaneous fees. Federal grants from the ARRA for human services, education, and other economic related stimulus programs total $878.9 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $594.8 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Major revenues from transfers of other State funds to the State’s General Fund and securitizations include (i) transferring Budget Reserve Funds of $1,039.7 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $342.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and (ii) securitizing $1,290.7 million in fiscal year 2010-11 as amended by Public Act No. 09-7 of the September 2009 Special Session. The significant tax changes include: (i) an increase in the highest income tax rate to 6.5% from 5% for those with taxable incomes over $1 million for joint filers, $800,000 for heads of households, and $500,000 for single filers and married people filing separately, raising approximately $594.0 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $400.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11; (ii) an imposition of a 10% corporation tax surcharge for the 2009, 2010, and 2011 income years on companies that have (1) $100 million or more in annual gross income in those years and (2) tax liability that exceeds the $250 minimum, raising approximately $74.1 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $41.1 million in fiscal year 2010-11; (iii) an increase in the cigarette tax rate from $2.00 per pack to $3.00 per pack, raising approximately $94.9 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $112.4 million in fiscal year 2010-11; (iv) changes in various fees, raising approximately a net total of $108.5 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $105.9 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and (v) cuts in taxes, including (1) a reduction in the sales and use tax rate to 5.5% from 6%, and (2) a reduction in the estate and gift tax. The reduction of the sales and use tax rate effective January 1, 2010 is expected to result in a revenue loss of approximately $129.5 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $268.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11. However, if any cumulative monthly financial statement issued by the Comptroller before January 1, 2010 indicated that the estimated gross tax revenue to the General Fund to the end of the fiscal year ending June 30, 2010 was at least 1% less than the adopted gross tax revenue to the General Fund for fiscal year 2009-10, the tax rate will remain at 6%. If any cumulative monthly financial statement issued after January 1, 2010, and on or before June 30, 2010, indicates that the estimated gross tax revenue to the General Fund to the end of the fiscal year ending June 30, 2010 is at least 1% less than the adopted gross tax revenue to the General Fund, the tax rate will remain at 6%. On the estate and gift taxes, the enacted law will (i) increase the threshold for the value of an estate or gift subject to the estate and gift taxes from $2 million to $3.5 million; (ii) reduce the marginal tax rates by 25%; and (iii) eliminate the tax cliff. These three measures were estimated to reduce revenues by approximately $5.9 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $70.3 million in fiscal year 2010-11.

The significant changes in appropriations are from State employee personal services reductions, entitlement programs savings, and education grants reductions. Personal services reductions from concessions with a coalition of employee collective bargaining units including wage freezes and a Retirement Incentive Plan are expected to save approximately $191.0 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $193.7 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Savings from entitlement programs include (i) eliminating nursing home rate increases in reimbursement levels under Medicaid, saving approximately $113.2 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $162.2 million in fiscal year 2010-11, (ii) reducing managed care organization capitation rates by 6% under both HUSKY A and HUSKY B, saving approximately $50.1 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $51.8 million in fiscal year 2010-11, and (iii) managing services for aged, blind and disabled individuals who are currently receiving care under the Medicaid fee-for-service program, saving approximately $27.8 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $80.0 million in fiscal year 2010-11. Education reductions include cuts of grants to (i) the Excess Cost program that reimburses funds to towns, saving approximately $13.4 million each for both fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11, (ii) the Priority School District program that assists the neediest communities and funds the School Readiness program, reducing $6.9 million each for both fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11, and (iii) the Reading Success program designed to improve kindergarten through grade three reading, saving the State $2.4 million each for both fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11.

 

D-6


Table of Contents

 

In addition, the budget for fiscal year 2010-11 requires the Treasurer and the Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management to jointly develop a financing plan that will result in net proceeds of up to $1,290.7 million to be used as general revenues of the State during such fiscal year, which may include securitizations as discussed above. The budget also requires the Treasurer and the Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management to jointly develop a plan to sell assets of the State that will result in net proceeds of up to $15 million to be used as general revenues of the State during the 2009-10 fiscal year and $45 million to be used as general revenues of the State during the 2010-11 fiscal year. In addition, the budget for fiscal year 2009-10 requires a reduction of $473.3 million in expenses from budgeted amounts. The budget for fiscal year 2010-11 requires a reduction of $515.2 million of expenses from budgeted amounts.

The budget was $852.4 million below the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2009-10 and $587.0 million below the expenditure cap in fiscal year 2010-11.

Fiscal Year 2009-2010 Operations. Pursuant to Section 4-66 of the Connecticut General Statutes, the Office of Policy and Management provides estimates to the Comptroller by the twentieth day of each month of revenues and expenditures for the current fiscal year for use by the Comptroller in preparing the Comptroller’s monthly report. In the monthly estimates provided by the Office of Policy and Management on October 20, 2009 for the General Fund for the 2009-10 fiscal year, as of the period ending September 30, 2009, General Fund revenues were estimated at $17,203.3 million, General Fund expenditures and miscellaneous adjustments were estimated at $17,591.8 million and the General Fund was estimated to have a deficit of $388.5 million. No assurances can be given that future report estimates will match the Office of Policy and Management’s prior estimates.

By statute, the State’s fiscal position is reported monthly by the Comptroller. In her monthly report dated October 1, 2009 for the period ending August 31, 2009, the Comptroller indicated that although many of the revenue enhancements associated with the budget had not yet appeared within the revenue collection figures, the first quarter revenue trends raised concerns. She indicated that if the first quarter trends continued unabated, even after fully incorporating the projected revenue gains enacted as part of the budget, the revenue shortfall in the General Fund for the 2009-10 fiscal year would exceed $500 million. She further indicated that because it was early in the fiscal year, there was sufficient time for a reversal in the trend to mitigate the shortfall. The Comptroller did not address any increased expenditures, which the Office of Policy and Management projected to be an additional $212.5 million in its October 20, 2009 report. In the Comptroller’s monthly report dated November 1, 2009, the Comptroller estimated a General Fund deficit for the 2009-10 fiscal year of $624 million as of the period ending September 30, 2009. No assurances can be given that future report estimates will match the Office of Policy and Management’s estimates or the Comptroller’s prior estimates.

The Governor may generally reduce budget allotment requests within certain prescribed limits and has done so for the current fiscal year. Additionally, as described above, pursuant to Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes, whenever the cumulative monthly financial statement issued by the Comptroller indicates a projected General Fund deficit greater than one percent of the total General Fund appropriations, the Governor is required within thirty days to file a report with the joint standing committees of the General Assembly on appropriations and on finance, revenue and bonding. The report must include a plan which the Governor must implement to modify agency allotments to the extent necessary to prevent a deficit. The Governor is required to file such report as a result of the deficit projection included in the Comptroller’s November 1, 2009 report.

The above projections are only estimates and the information in the monthly letters of the Office of Policy and Management to the Comptroller and in the Comptroller’s monthly reports contain only estimates and no assurances can be given that future events will materialize as estimated or that subsequent estimates, adjustments or audit or actions of the General Assembly will not indicate changes in the final result of the fiscal year 2009-10 operations of the General Fund.

 

D-7


Table of Contents

 

STATE DEBT

Types of State Debt. Pursuant to various public and special acts the State has authorized a variety of types of debt. These types fall generally into the following categories: direct general obligation debt, which is payable from the State’s General Fund; special tax obligation debt, which is payable from specified taxes and other funds which are maintained outside the State’s General Fund; and special obligation and revenue debt, which is payable from specified revenues or other funds which are maintained outside the State’s General Fund. In addition, the State has a number of programs under which the State provides annual appropriation support for, or is contingently liable on, the debt of certain State quasi-public agencies and political subdivisions.

State Direct General Obligation Debt. Statutory Authorization and Security Provisions. In general, the State issues general obligation bonds pursuant to specific statutory bond acts and Section 3-20 of the General Statutes, the State general obligation bond procedure act. That act provides that such bonds shall be general obligations of the State and that the full faith and credit of the State of Connecticut are pledged for the payment of the principal of and interest on such bonds as the same become due. Such act further provides that, as a part of the contract of the State with the owners of such bonds, appropriation of all amounts necessary for the punctual payment of such principal and interest will be made, and the Treasurer will pay such principal and interest as the same become due.

There are no State constitutional provisions precluding the exercise of State power by statute to impose any taxes, including taxes on taxable property in the State or on income, in order to pay debt service on bonded debt now or hereafter incurred. The constitutional limit on increases in General Fund expenditures for any fiscal year does not include expenditures for the payment of bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness. There are also no constitutional or statutory provisions requiring or precluding the enactment of liens on or pledges of State General Fund revenues or taxes, or the establishment of priorities for payment of debt service on the State’s general obligation bonds. There are no express statutory provisions establishing any priorities in favor of general obligation bondholders over other valid claims against the State.

Statutory Debt Limit. Section 3-21 of the General Statutes provides that no bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness for borrowed money payable from General Fund tax receipts of the State may be authorized by the General Assembly or issued unless they do not cause the aggregate amount of (1) the total amount of bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness payable from General Fund tax receipts authorized by the General Assembly but which have not been issued and (2) the total amount of such indebtedness which has been issued and remains outstanding, to exceed 1.6 times the total estimated General Fund tax receipts of the State for the fiscal year in which any such authorization will become effective or in which such indebtedness is issued, as estimated for such fiscal year by the joint standing committee of the General Assembly having cognizance of finance, revenue and bonding. However, in computing the aggregate amount of indebtedness at any time, revenue anticipation notes having a maturity of one year or less, refunded indebtedness, bond anticipation notes, borrowings payable solely from the revenues of a particular project, the balances of debt retirement funds associated with indebtedness subject to the debt limit as certified by the Treasurer, the amount of federal grants certified by the Secretary of OPM as receivable to meet the principal of certain indebtedness, all authorized and issued indebtedness to fund any budget deficits of the State for any fiscal year ending on or before June 30, 1991 and for the fiscal years ending June 30, 2002 and June 30, 2003, all authorized debt to fund the Connecticut Development Authority’s tax increment bond program, any indebtedness represented by agreements entered into pursuant to certain provisions of the General Statutes, provided the indebtedness in connection with which such agreements were entered into shall be included in such aggregate amount of indebtedness, any indebtedness issued for the purpose of meeting cash flow needs, and any indebtedness issued for the purpose of covering emergency needs in times of natural disaster are excluded or deducted. For purposes of the debt limit statute, all bonds and notes issued or guaranteed by the State and payable from General Fund tax receipts are counted against the limit, except for the exclusions or deductions described above. In addition, the amount of authorized but unissued debt for the UConn 2000 program is limited to the amount permitted to be issued under the cap.

 

D-8


Table of Contents

 

Under the General Statutes, the Treasurer is required to compute the aggregate amount of indebtedness as of January 1 and July 1 each year and to certify the results of such computation to the Governor and the General Assembly. If the aggregate amount of indebtedness reaches 90% of the statutory debt limit, the Governor must review each bond act for which no bonds, notes or other evidences of indebtedness have been issued, and recommend to the General Assembly priorities for repealing authorizations for remaining projects.

Certain Short-Term Borrowings. The General Statutes authorize the Treasurer, subject to the approval of the Governor, to borrow such funds, from time to time, as may be necessary, and to issue obligations of the State therefor, which must be redeemed by the Treasurer whenever, in the opinion of the Treasurer, there are funds in the treasury available for such purpose. The State has established programs of temporary note issuances from time to time to cover periodic cash flow requirements. On June 18, 2009, pursuant to the Treasurer’s request and the Governor’s approval to borrow funds on a temporary basis from time to time on behalf of the State, the Treasurer arranged with a group of banks a 364-day revolving credit facility in the amount of $580 million.

OTHER FUNDS, DEBT AND LIABILITIES

The State conducts certain of its operations through State funds other than the State General Fund and, pursuant to legislation, may issue debt secured by the special taxes or revenues pledged to certain of such funds. In addition, the State is contingently liable or has limited liability, from the resources of the State’s General Fund, for payment of debt service on certain obligations of quasi-public State agencies and municipalities of the State. The State has also made commitments to municipalities to make future grant payments for school construction projects, payable over a period of years. In addition, the State has committed to apply moneys for debt service on loans to finance child care facilities and has certain other contingent liabilities for future payments.

Transportation Fund and Debt. In 1984 the State adopted legislation establishing a transportation infrastructure program and authorizing special tax obligation (“STO”) bonds to finance the program. The infrastructure program is a continuous program for planning, construction and improvement of State highways and bridges, projects on the interstate highway system, alternate highway projects in the interstate highway substitution program, waterway facilities, mass transportation and transit facilities, aeronautic facilities (excluding Bradley International Airport), the highway safety program, maintenance garages and administrative facilities of the Department of Transportation, payment of the State’s share of the costs of the local bridge program established under the act, and payment of State contributions to the local bridge revolving fund established under the act. The infrastructure program is administered by the Department of Transportation.

The cost of the infrastructure program for State fiscal years 1985-2012, which will be met from federal, State and local funds, is currently estimated at $23.5 billion. The State’s share of such cost, estimated at $9.5 billion, is to be funded from transportation related taxes, fees and revenues deposited in the Special Transportation Fund, as described below, and from the proceeds of STO bonds. The portion of State program costs not financed by STO bonds is estimated at $0.6 billion and includes the expenses of the infrastructure program that either are not sufficiently large or do not have a sufficiently long life expectancy to justify the issuance of long-term bonds. Such expenses currently include liquid resurfacing, minor bridge repairs, highway maintenance activities, safety improvements and other minor transportation improvements.

The State’s share of the cost of the Infrastructure Program for State fiscal years 1985-2012 to be financed by STO bonds currently is estimated at $8.9 billion. The actual amount may exceed $8.9 billion to finance reserves and cost of issuance amounts. The issuance of such STO bonds has eliminated the need for the authorization of additional general obligation bonds of the State for surface transportation purposes. STO bonds may also be issued for the purpose of refunding general obligation bonds of the State issued for transportation infrastructure purposes.

 

D-9


Table of Contents

 

During fiscal years 1985-2007, $18.3 billion of the total infrastructure program was approved by the appropriate governmental authorities. The remaining $5.2 billion is required for fiscal years 2008-2012. The $5.2 billion of such infrastructure costs is anticipated to be funded with proceeds of $1.8 billion from the anticipated issuance of new STO bonds, $63 million in anticipated revenues, and $3.3 billion in anticipated federal funds.

The State has established the Special Transportation Fund for the purpose of budgeting and accounting for all transportation related taxes, fees and revenues credited to such Fund and securing the STO bonds. STO bonds are payable solely from revenues of the Special Transportation Fund. The aggregate of certain motor fuel taxes, motor vehicle receipts, motor vehicle related licenses, permits and fees, and portions of the oil companies tax and sales tax on motor vehicles and other transportation related revenue sources, including enacted adjustments to all the foregoing sources, are intended to cover the cost of the State’s share of the infrastructure program, including debt service requirements. After providing for debt service requirements, the balance of the receipts from such revenue sources may be applied to the payment of general obligation bonds of the State issued for transportation purposes and for the payment of annually budgeted expenses of the Department of Transportation and the Department of Motor Vehicles.

It is anticipated that additional STO bonds will be authorized by the General Assembly annually in an amount necessary to finance and to complete the infrastructure program. Such additional bonds may be issued on an equal rank with the outstanding bonds provided certain pledged revenue coverage requirements of the STO indentures controlling the issuance of such bonds are met. The State expects to continue to offer bonds for this program.

In addition to STO Bonds, the State has issued direct general obligation bonds for transportation purposes and the debt service on these bonds may be paid from resources of the Special Transportation Fund provided there is sufficient funding first to pay all STO debt service. For the year ended June 30, 2008 the Special Transportation Fund paid $3.1 million of State direct general obligation transportation debt service payments. The amount budgeted by the Special Transportation Fund for State direct general obligation transportation debt service payments for fiscal year 2008-09 was $2.0 million

During the past several years the Fund’s revenues and expenses have undergone a variety of legislative changes. In 2003 legislation provided for a one-time transfer of $52 million from the Fund to the State’s General Fund. In 2004 legislation increased the tax on gasohol and raised various motor vehicle fees resulting in an $18.6 million benefit to the Fund. In 2005 legislation increased the scheduled transfers to the Fund from the State’s General Fund from Oil Companies Tax revenue by $22.5 million in fiscal year 2006, $30 million in fiscal year 2007, $53 million in fiscal year 2008, $79.9 million in each of fiscal years 2009-2013, and $98 million thereafter. In 2006, legislation again increased the scheduled transfers to the Fund from the State’s General Fund from Oil Companies Tax revenue by $80 million in each of fiscal years 2007-2010 and by $100 million in fiscal year 2011 and thereafter. In July 2007 legislation increased the motor fuels tax on each gallon of diesel fuel from $0.26 to $0.37 and correspondingly exempted diesel fuel from the petroleum products gross earnings tax.

A fifteen member Transportation Strategy Board (“TSB”) was established in 2001 to propose a transportation strategy, an implementation cost estimate and funding approaches to the Governor and General Assembly. The TSB’s strategic goals are: 1) improve personal mobility within and through Connecticut; 2) improve the movement of goods and freight within and through Connecticut; 3) integrate transportation with economic, land use, environmental and quality of life issues; 4) develop policies and procedures that will integrate the state economy with regional, national and global economies; and 5) identify policies and sources that provide an adequate and reliable flow of funding necessary for a quality multi-modal transportation system. The TSB presented the initial transportation strategy to the Governor and General Assembly on January 6, 2003. In January 2007, as required in Public Act No. 06-136, the TSB again presented “Connecticut’s Transportation Strategy” to the Governor and General Assembly.

 

D-10


Table of Contents

 

In order to implement the strategy-related projects submitted by TSB, legislation was passed in 2005 that established fixed transfers from the Special Transportation Fund to the TSB project accounts in the amounts of $25.3 million in fiscal year 2005-06, $20.3 million in fiscal year 2006-07, $15.3 million in each of fiscal years 2007-08 through 2014-15 and $0.3 million in fiscal year 2015-16 and thereafter. In September 2007 legislation authorized the transfer of $5.5 million on deposit in the Special Transportation Fund to the TSB’s project account for various transportation related studies.

Public Acts in 2005 and 2006 authorized the issuance of more than $2.1 billion of special tax obligation bonds for the ten-year period from 2005 to 2014 for transportation system improvements, many of which are TSB-recommended projects. As of February 1, 2009 $2.0 billion of the borrowing authorized is effective with the remaining $100 million becoming effective in fiscal year 2009-10. Legislation passed in 2006 also authorized the issuance of $1.3 billion in bonds in anticipation of future federal transportation funds. Pursuant to Public Act No. 09-2 of the September 2009 Special Session, the General Assembly has authorized special tax obligation bonds of $579.2 million in fiscal year 2009-10 and $265.4 million in fiscal year 2010-11. In November 2009, the State issued $195,970,000 Special Tax Obligation Bonds Transportation Infrastructure Purposes, 2009 Series A, $304,030,000 Special Tax Obligation Bonds Transportation Infrastructure Purposes, 2009 Series B (Taxable Build America Bonds—Direct Pay), and $49,775,000 Special Tax Obligation Refunding Bonds Transportation Infrastructure Purposes, 2009 Series C.

Other Special Revenue Funds and Debt

Bradley Airport. Bradley International Airport, located in Windsor Locks, Connecticut, is owned by the State and operated by the Bureau of Aviation and Ports in the State’s Department of Transportation. The General Assembly has authorized the issuance of revenue bonds for improvements at Bradley International Airport, payable from all or a portion of the revenues generated at the airport. Legislation passed in 2001 removed a $294 million bond issuance cap for Bradley Airport but retained the requirement for State Bond Commission approval of any new bond issue. As of February 1, 2009, there were $198.9 million of Bradley International Airport Revenue Bonds outstanding.

The 2001 legislation also established a board of directors to oversee the operation and development of Bradley Airport. The seven-member board includes five appointed members and the Commissioners of Transportation and Economic and Community Development. The Bradley board is charged with a wide range of duties and responsibilities, including developing an organizational and management structure, approving the annual capital and operating budget, master plan, and community relations policies of the airport, and ensuring customer service standards and performance assessments.

Additional special obligation bonds to finance self-sustaining special facilities at Bradley International Airport payable solely from the revenues derived from such special facilities were authorized in 1993. In March 2000 the State issued $53.8 million of Bradley International Airport Special Obligation Parking Revenue Bonds to finance the construction of a five story parking garage facility at the airport and, as of February 1, 2009, $44.7 million of such bonds were outstanding.

The board of directors of Bradley Airport and the State Bond Commission approved a transaction authorizing the State Treasurer to refund Bradley International Airport General Airport Revenue Bonds, Series 2001A (AMT) for expected delivery in 2011 or thereafter and to enter into a forward starting interest rate swap transaction for the purpose of locking in current market savings. Pursuant to such authorization the State entered into certain swap agreements in April 2006.

Clean Water Fund. The General Assembly has authorized the issue of up to $1,753.4 million of revenue bonds, of which $1,209.28 million have been issued, for the purpose of funding various State and federally mandated water pollution control and drinking water projects. The revenue bonds are payable solely from the revenues or other receipts, funds or moneys pledged therefor. The proceeds of the revenue bonds are loaned

 

D-11


Table of Contents

primarily to Connecticut municipalities to finance water pollution control and drinking water improvements, and the loan repayments by the municipalities secure the bonds. The loans are evidenced by interim funding obligations and project loan obligations of the municipalities, pursuant to which either the full faith and credit of each such municipality is pledged, or the revenues and other funds of a municipal sewer system are pledged. The General Assembly has authorized the issue of up to $1,833.4 million of revenue bonds, of which $1,408.7 million has been issued, for the purpose of funding various State and federally mandated water pollution control and drinking water projects. As of October 1, 2009 $853.9 million of revenue bonds were outstanding (including refunding bonds).

Unemployment Compensation. The State pays unemployment compensation benefits from the State’s Unemployment Compensation Fund, which is funded by unemployment compensation taxes collected from employers. In 1993, the State responded to a deficit in the Fund by, among other things, issuing three series of special obligation bonds totaling $1,020.7 million to repay certain federal borrowings and to fund certain reserves. All of these bonds were defeased in June 2001. To fund future shortfalls, the State has reserved the authority to issue bonds in an aggregate amount outstanding at any time not in excess of $1,000 million, plus amounts for certain reserves and costs of issuance. The State has not incurred any additional borrowing since 1993 other than borrowings from the Federal Unemployment Trust Fund for cash flow purposes, which have been repaid prior to September 30 in each case and which therefore have not been subject to federal interest charges.

Second Injury Fund. The Second Injury Fund is a State-run workers’ compensation insurance fund which pays lost wages and medical benefits to qualified injured workers. The State established the Second Injury Fund in 1945 to encourage the hiring of persons with pre-existing physical impairments, such as veterans, and to provide relief to employers when an injured worker, who already had a pre-existing injury or condition, was hurt on the job and the second injury was made worse by the existence of the first injury. In 1995 and 1996, the State enacted legislation to close the Second Injury Fund to future second injury claims. Those laws authorized the issuance of an amount not to exceed $750 million in revenue bonds and notes outstanding at any one time to provide funds for paying past claims. No bonds are currently outstanding. The State’s management objective is to pay additional claims and settlements from current income and, if necessary, short term borrowings.

Rate Reduction Bonds. The General Assembly authorized the issuance of special obligation bonds to sustain funding of the conservation and load management and the renewable energy investment programs established under the general statutes. The State issued $205.3 million of Special Obligation Rate Reduction Bonds (2004 Series A) in June 2004. These bonds were defeased on June 5, 2008. The bonds were secured by certain revenues collected through a non-bypassable charge imposed upon each customer of the electric utilities within the State. Such revenues are property of the State and are pledged towards payment of debt service on the bonds and related costs, which pledge is a first priority lien on such revenues. The net proceeds of the bonds were deposited in the General Fund.

Contingent Liability Debt. The General Assembly has the power to impose limited or contingent liabilities upon the State in such a manner as it may deem appropriate and as may serve a public purpose. This power has been used to support the efforts of quasi-public agencies, municipalities and other authorities formed to carry out essential public and governmental functions by authorizing these entities to issue indebtedness backed, partially or fully, by General Fund resources of the State. Not all entities that are authorized to issue such indebtedness have done so, and the description below of the State’s limited or contingent liability is restricted only to specific indebtedness backed by the State.

Special Capital Reserve Funds. The primary vehicle through which the State has undertaken contingent or limited liability is the special capital reserve fund. A special capital reserve fund, if established, provides additional security for bonds issued by the entity authorized to establish such a reserve fund. Subject to exceptions in the legislation authorizing the establishment of a particular special capital reserve fund, monies held in and credited to a special capital reserve fund are intended to be used solely for the payment of the

 

D-12


Table of Contents

principal of bonds secured by such special capital reserve fund, the purchase of such bonds, the payment of interest on such bonds or the payment of any redemption premium required to be paid when such bonds are redeemed prior to maturity. The special capital reserve fund is frequently funded with bond proceeds to a specified amount (the minimum of which is often the maximum annual principal and interest payments due on the bonds). The State undertakes the obligation to restore a special capital reserve fund to its minimum level. The method for determining such required minimum capital reserve is set out in the legislation authorizing the special capital reserve fund. If the special capital reserve fund should fall below the required minimum capital reserve amount, an official of the authority or municipality which established the special capital reserve fund must certify to the Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management or the State Treasurer or both the amount necessary to restore such special capital reserve fund to the required minimum capital reserve amount. On or before December 1, annually, the amount specified in the certificate is deemed to be appropriated from the State’s General Fund and must be allotted and paid to the entity that established the special capital reserve fund. On an annual basis, the State’s liability under any special capital reserve fund mechanism is limited to its obligation to restore that fund to its minimum capital reserve amount.

Quasi-Public Agencies. The State has established by legislation several quasi-public agencies. These quasi-public agencies are not departments, institutions or agencies of the State. They are, however, bodies politic and corporate that constitute public instrumentalities and political subdivisions of the State and whose exercise of authority granted to them is deemed to be the performance of an essential public and governmental function. These organizations provide a wide range of services that might otherwise be provided directly by the State. Among the public authorities are: the Connecticut Development Authority, the Connecticut Health and Educational Facilities Authority, the Connecticut Higher Education Supplemental Loan Authority, the Connecticut Housing Finance Authority, the Connecticut Resources Recovery Authority and the Capital City Economic Development Authority. Each of these public authorities is authorized to issue bonds in its own name to facilitate its activities and each has issued bonds secured by a special capital reserve fund, or other contractual arrangement, for which the State has limited contingent liability.

Assistance to Municipalities. In addition to the limited or contingent liabilities that the State has undertaken in connection with the activities of its quasi-public agencies, the State has undertaken certain limited or contingent liabilities to assist municipalities. The State currently has limited or contingent liabilities outstanding in connection with bonds or other obligations issued by the City of Waterbury and the Southeastern Connecticut Water Authority. The State previously was obligated pursuant to the establishment of a special capital reserve fund to secure certain bonds issued by the City of Bridgeport to fund its past budget deficits; however such bonds were refunded by the city in 1996. The State previously had guaranteed debt service on bonds of the City of West Haven, but an irrevocable escrow has been established to pay such bonds. Legislation also authorized distressed municipalities, in certain circumstances and subject to various conditions, to issue deficit funding obligations secured by a special capital reserve fund. There are no such obligations currently outstanding.

School Construction Grant Commitments. The State is obligated to various cities, towns and regional school districts under a grant-in-aid public school building program to fund certain of the costs of construction and alteration of school buildings or to support part of the debt service payments on municipal debt issued to fund the State’s share of such school building projects. For certain school projects approved by the General Assembly, cities, towns and districts are ranked according to their adjusted equalized net grand list per capita and based on such rankings a percentage is assigned which determines the amount of grant money a town or regional school district is eligible to receive for a project or type of project authorized by the legislature and approved by the Commissioner of Education.

For school construction projects approved during the 1997 legislative session and thereafter, the State pays the costs of its share of construction projects on a progress payment basis during the construction period. Each year the legislature authorizes grant commitments which vary in amounts from year to year. The State has authorized new school construction grant commitments of approximately $400 million which take effect in the 2009-10 fiscal year. As of June 30, 2009, the Commissioner estimates that current grant obligations under the

 

D-13


Table of Contents

grant program established in 1997 are approximately $2,450 million, which includes approximately $6,900 million of grants approved as of such date less payments already made of $4,450 million.

Prior to 1997 the grant program was conducted differently. For certain school projects grants for construction costs are paid to the cities, towns and districts in installments which correspond to the number and time of principal payments due on municipal bonds, or temporary notes renewed for a third or subsequent year, issued to finance project costs. If a project is fully paid from sources other than borrowing, such grants are paid in five annual installments. Grants in support of interest payments correspond to the number and time of such interest payments. As of June 30, 2009, under the grant program prior to 1997 the State is obligated to various cities, towns and regional school districts for approximately $314 million in aggregate principal installment payments and $57 million aggregate interest subsidies, for a total of $371 million. Funding for these payments may come from future State direct general obligation bond sales. No new grant commitment can be authorized under this program.

The legislature has authorized bonds for both grant programs based on the amount of grants that the Commissioner of Education estimates will be paid during each fiscal year. Since there is generally a lapse of one or more years from the time grant commitments are approved to the time grant payments are required to be made, the amount of unpaid grant commitments will be significantly greater than the amount of bonds authorized to fund the grant commitments.

Child Care Facilities Debt Service Commitments. Legislation enacted in 1997 authorized the Connecticut Health and Educational Facilities Authority (CHEFA) to issue bonds and loan the proceeds to various entities to finance child care facilities. The Department of Social Services may enter into commitments to apply monies for each such entity to pay the debt service on the loans in amounts sufficient to cover a portion of the debt service on CHEFA’s bonds. Legislation enacted in 1999 provided for the obligation of the Department of Social Services to make debt service payments to be made by the State Treasurer. Any obligation by the Department of Social Services or the State Treasurer to pay is subject to annual appropriation. CHEFA first issued special obligation bonds under this program in 1998. As of February 1, 2009 CHEFA had approximately $69.6 million bonds outstanding under this program with annual debt service of approximately $5.4 million, of which the Department of Social Services is committed to pay approximately $4.5 million. The remaining portion of debt service is to be paid from Department of Education and Department of Social Services intercepts of revenues from providers. Two other Child Care Facilities programs also authorize the Commissioner of the Department of Social Services to enter into guaranties of loans made to entities to finance the development of child care and child development centers or programs. CHEFA is administering this program on behalf of the Department, and is currently limiting the aggregate amount of guaranties to the balance of monies in the reserve funds for the respective programs.

Other Contingent Liabilities. The Connecticut Lottery Corporation (the “Corporation”) was created in 1996 as a public instrumentality of the State to operate the State’s lottery pursuant to the Connecticut Lottery Corporation Act (the “CLC Act”). The State and the Corporation purchase annuities under group contracts with insurance companies which provide payments corresponding to the obligation for payments to lottery prize winners. The State has transferred to the Corporation all annuities purchased by it and the Corporation has assumed responsibility for the collection of revenue generated from the lottery and for the payment of all lottery prizes. Under the CLC Act, the termination of the Corporation would not affect any outstanding contractual obligation of the Corporation and the State would succeed to the obligations of the Corporation under any such contract. As of June 30, 2008 the current and long term liabilities of the Corporation total $291 million.

PENSION AND RETIREMENT SYSTEMS

State Employees’ Retirement Fund. The State Employees’ Retirement Fund is one of the systems maintained by the State with approximately 53,196 active members, 1,592 inactive (vested) members and 38,093 retired members as of June 30, 2008. Generally, employees hired before July 1, 1984 participate in the Tier I plan, which includes employee contributions. As of July 1, 2008 approximately 13% of the total work force was

 

D-14


Table of Contents

covered under the Tier I Plan. Other employees generally participate in the Tier II plan, which is non-contributory and provides somewhat lesser benefits. As of July 1, 2008, approximately 42% of the total workforce was covered under the Tier II plan. Employees hired after July 1, 1997 participate in the Tier IIA plan, which requires contributions from its employee members. As of July 1, 2008, approximately 45% of the total work force was covered under the Tier IIA Plan. Since fiscal year 1978-79, payments into the State Employees’ Retirement Fund and investment income in each fiscal year, with the exception of fiscal year 2003-04, have been sufficient to meet benefits paid from the fund in such year. Payments into the fund are made from employee contributions, General and Special Transportation Fund appropriations and grant reimbursements from Federal and other funds. State contributions to the fund are made monthly on the basis of transfers submitted by the Office of the State Comptroller.

Full actuarial valuations are performed as of June 30th of each even-numbered year. The most recent actuarial valuation of November 2008 indicated that, as of June 30, 2007, the State Employees’ Retirement Fund had assets with an actuarial value of $9,585 0 million and as of June 30, 2008, the State Employees’ Retirement Fund had assets with an actuarial value of $9,990.2 million. The actuarial valuation was based upon an 8.25% earnings assumption and the effect of phasing in an approximately 4.8% negative return on plan assets for the 2007-08 fiscal year. The Treasurer has realized an annualized net return of 6.06% on investment assets in the State Employees’ Retirement Fund over the past ten years (fiscal year 1998-99 through fiscal year 2007-08) and an annualized net return of 9.43% over the past five years (fiscal year 2003-04 through fiscal year 2007-08). The November 2008 actuarial valuation indicated that as of June 30, 2008 the State Employees’ Retirement Fund had a funded ratio of 51.9% on a projected basis. As of June 30, 2008 the market value of the fund’s investment assets, as reported in the actuarial valuation, was $9,329,175,038. The market value of the fund’s investment assets is continually subject to change based on a variety of factors, including changes in the financial and credit markets and general economic conditions, and the current market value of the fund’s investment assets is lower than it was at June 30, 2008. As of June 30, 2009, the market value of the fund’s investment assets was $7,320,843,712.

The November 2008 actuarial valuation determined the following employer contribution requirements, based on a projected unit credit actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions, which contributions are sufficient to meet Governmental Accounting Standards Board (“GASB”) standards: (i) $897.4 million for fiscal year 2009-10, and (ii) $944.1 million for fiscal year 2010-11. The annual contribution requirements for fiscal years 2009-10 and 2010-11 include amounts which may be required pursuant to the Supreme Court’s decision in the case of Longley v. State Employees Retirement Commission, which requires that the plaintiffs’ final pro-rated longevity payment be included in the earnings calculations for purposes of calculating their retirement incomes. The State met 99.25% of its annual contribution requirement for fiscal year 2007-08. To meet the State’s annual contribution requirements for fiscal year 2008-09, $575.8 million was appropriated from the General Fund and the Special Transportation Fund. The Office of Policy and Management projects that contributions to the fund for fiscal year 2008-09 from grant reimbursements from federal and other funds will be sufficient to meet the balance of the required annual contribution.

Teachers’ Retirement Fund. The Teachers’ Retirement Fund, administered by the Teachers’ Retirement Board, provides benefits for any teacher, principal, supervisor, superintendent or other eligible employee in the public school systems of the State, with certain exceptions. While establishing salary schedules for teachers, municipalities do not provide contributions to the maintenance of the fund. As of June 30, 2008, there were 61,421 active and former employees with accrued and accruing benefits and 28,609 retired members.

Since fiscal year 1978-79, payments into the Teachers’ Retirement Fund and investment income in each fiscal year, with the exception of fiscal years 2003-04 and 2004-05, have been sufficient to meet benefits paid from the fund in such year. Contributions to the fund are made by employees and by General Fund appropriations from the State. State contributions to the fund are made quarterly on the basis of certifications submitted by the Teachers’ Retirement Board and are funded with annual appropriations from the General Fund.

 

D-15


Table of Contents

 

Actuarial valuations are performed as of June 30th of each even-numbered year. The most recent actuarial valuation dated November 12, 2008 indicated that, as of June 30, 2008, the Teachers’ Retirement Fund had assets, inclusive of the cost-of-living adjustment reserve account, with an actuarial value of $15,271.0 million. The actuarial valuation was based upon an 8.50% earnings assumption. The Treasurer has realized an annualized net return of 6.13% on investment assets in the Teachers’ Retirement Fund over the past ten years (fiscal year 1998-99 through fiscal year 2007-08) and an annualized net return of 9.56% over the past five years (fiscal year 2003-04 through fiscal year 2007-08). The November 2008 actuarial valuation indicated that as of June 30, 2008 the Teachers’ Retirement Fund had a funded ratio of 70.1% on a projected basis. As of June 30, 2008, the market value of the fund’s investment assets, as reported in the actuarial valuation, was $14,551,467,434. The market value of the fund’s investment assets is continually subject to change based on a variety of factors, including changes in the financial and credit markets and general economic conditions and the current market value of the fund’s investment assets is lower than it was at June 30, 2008. As of June 30, 2009, the market value of the fund’s investment assets was $11,396,681,762.

The actuarial valuation dated November 29, 2006 determined the following employer contribution requirements, based on an individual entry-age actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions, which contributions are sufficient to meet GASB standards: (i) $518.6 million for fiscal year 2007-08, and (ii) $539.3 million for fiscal year 2008-09. The State met its annual contribution requirement for fiscal year 2007-08. To meet the State’s annual contribution requirement for fiscal year 2008-09, $539.3 million has been appropriated. The actuarial valuation dated November 12, 2008 determined the following employer contribution requirements, which are sufficient to meet GASB standards: (i) $559.2 million for fiscal year 2009-10, and (ii) $581.6 million for fiscal year 2010-11.

Public Act No. 07-186 authorized the issuance of general obligation bonds (“TRF Bonds”) of the State in amounts sufficient to fund a $2.0 billion deposit to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund plus amounts required for costs of issuance and up to two years of capitalized interest. The Secretary of the Office of Policy and Management and the State Treasurer subsequently determined that issuance of such bonds would be in the best interests of the State, and in April 2008 the State issued $2,276,578,270.75 of such bonds.

Section 8 of Public Act No. 07-186 provides that, in each fiscal year that any TRF Bonds (or any refunding bonds) are outstanding, an amount equal to the annual required contribution to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund is deemed to be appropriated from the General Fund, and such amount must be deposited in the fund in such fiscal year. The amounts of the annual required contributions for each biennial budget are based on the actuarial valuation required to be completed by the December 1 prior to the beginning of the next biennial budget. Under Section 8 the State has pledged to and agreed with the holders of any TRF Bonds that, so long as the actuarial evaluation of the Teachers’ Retirement Fund is completed and the certification of the annual contribution amounts is made as required by Section 8, no public or special act of the General Assembly shall diminish such required contribution until such bonds, together with interest thereon, are fully met and discharged unless adequate provision is made by law for the protection of the holders of the bonds. Such contributions may be reduced in any biennium, however, if (i) the Governor declares an emergency or the existence of extraordinary circumstances (which may include changes in actuarial methods or accounting standards) in which the provisions of Section 4-85 of the Connecticut General Statutes is invoked, (ii) at least three-fifths of the members of each Chamber of the General Assembly vote to diminish such required contributions during the biennium for which the emergency or extraordinary circumstances are determined, and (iii) the funded ratio of the fund is at least equal to the funded ratio immediately after the sale of the bonds in accordance with the actuarial method used at the time. If such conditions are met, the funding of the annual required actuarial contribution may be diminished, but in no event may such diminution result in a reduction of the funded ratio of the fund by more than 5% from (i) the funded ratio which would otherwise have resulted had the State funded the full required contribution or (ii) the funded ratio immediately after the sale of the bonds, whichever is greater.

The statutory provisions that govern pension benefits payable from the Teachers’ Retirement Fund include certain cost of living adjustments. Public Act No. 07-186 added a provision limiting cost-of-living adjustments

 

D-16


Table of Contents

for employees hired after July 1, 2007, but also removed a statutory provision that subjected certain annual cost of living adjustments in pension benefits to a limit based on funds available from earnings on fund investments which exceeded an 11.5% return. Such excess earnings were held in the cost-of-living adjustment reserve account until applied to provide for cost of living adjustments. Although there are other statutory limits on the cost of living adjustments, it is anticipated that the removal of the limit based on available earnings that exceeded an 11.5% return will cause an increase in the aggregate actuarial accrued liability of the fund. One preliminary report estimated that these changes could increase the unfunded actuarial accrued liability by approximately $1.0 billion. This preliminary estimate was based on various assumptions and no assurances can be given that subsequent projections or the next actuarial report will not result in a higher estimate.

Other Retirement Systems. The other minor retirement systems funded by the State include the Judges, Family Support Magistrates and Compensation Commissioners Retirement System (the Judicial Retirement System), the General Assembly Pension System, the State Attorneys’ Retirement Fund and the Public Defenders’ Retirement Fund. As of June 30, 2008, there were approximately 225 active members of these plans and approximately 254 retired members. Unclassified employees of the Connecticut State System of Higher Education and the central office staff of the Department of Higher Education are eligible to participate in the Connecticut Alternate Retirement Program. This program is a defined contribution program, and thus the State has no unfunded liability with respect to the program. All member contributions and State appropriations are held in a separate retirement fund by the Treasurer who may invest and reinvest as much of the fund’s assets as are not required for current disbursements, which are composed primarily of benefit payments. Any employee who elects or has elected to participate in the program may elect to receive a refund of all contributions made by the employee into the state employees retirement system in lieu of receiving any pension benefits under said retirement system.

The State is the administrator of the Connecticut Municipal Employees’ Retirement System and the Connecticut Probate Judges and Employees’ Retirement System. As the administrator of these systems the State owes a fiduciary obligation to these systems; however, the State has no direct financial liability to pay benefits under these systems.

Social Security and Other Post-Employment Benefits. State employees, except for police and members of a retirement system other than the State Employees’ Retirement Fund, whose employment commenced after February 21, 1958 are entitled to Social Security coverage. Certain employees hired prior to that date have also elected to be covered. Pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement, state police hired on or after May 8, 1984 are entitled to Social Security coverage. As of June 30, 2008, approximately 62,828 State employees were entitled to Social Security coverage. The amount expended by the State for Social Security coverage for fiscal year 2007-08 was $298.6 million Of this amount, $221.3 million was paid from the General Fund and $14.4 million was paid from the Special Transportation Fund.

The State provides post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits to all employees who retire from State employment. The State finances the cost of such benefits on a pay-as-you-go basis; as such, the State has not established any fund for the accumulation of assets with which to pay post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits in future years. The State will need to make significant General Fund appropriations for such benefits each fiscal year. For fiscal year 2008-09 $484.2 million was appropriated.

Implementation of GASB Statement No. 45 regarding accounting and financial reporting for postemployment benefits other than pensions requires the State to obtain an analysis of the unfunded actuarial accrued liability of such post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits and to recognize the annual required contribution to fund that actuarial liability in its financial statements commencing with those for fiscal year 2007-08. The State has received an actuarial report dated March 2007 with respect to the State’s liability for post-retirement health care benefits for persons covered under the State Employees Retirement System and other State retirement systems, excluding the Teachers’ Retirement System. The report indicated an OPEB actuarial accrued liability as of April 1, 2006 estimated to range from $11.4 billion to $21.7 billion. The amounts depend

 

D-17


Table of Contents

upon various assumptions including those with respect to medical cost inflation rates, the establishment of a trust to fund those liabilities, the amount of initial and annual amounts deposited in such a trust and discount rates. The report used discount rates ranging from 4.5% to 8.5%. The amount of the annual required contribution under these various assumptions ranged from $1.0 billion to $1.6 billion for fiscal year 2006-07, based on a projected unit credit actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions. Additional assumptions were also tested for sensitivity analysis which produced different results. The annual required contribution included the cost for both current eligible employees and retirees. The State has received an interim actuarial valuation dated February 16, 2009 with respect to the State’s liability for post-retirement health care benefits for persons covered under the State Employees Retirement System and other State retirement systems, excluding the Teachers’ Retirement System, based upon the stated assumptions of the March 2007 actuarial report but reflecting actual increases in the State’s medical and dental costs between April 1, 2006 and June 30, 2008. The report indicates an OPEB actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2007 of up to $23.1 billion and a projected actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2008 of up to $24.6 billion on an unfunded basis with no valuation assets available to offset the liabilities of the plan. The interim actuarial valuation determined an employer contribution requirement for fiscal year 2007-08 of up to $1.66 billion on an unfunded basis, based on a projected unit credit actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions. The State paid $458.4 million for eligible employees and $415.4 million for retirees for health care costs in fiscal year 2006-07. The State paid $480.0 million for eligible employees and $468.8 million for retirees for health care costs in fiscal year 2007-08.

The State makes a General Fund appropriation to the Teachers’ Retirement Fund to cover one-third of retiree health insurance costs plus any portion of the balance of such costs which is not funded from the amounts available in the Teachers’ Retirement Health Insurance Fund. The amount of $24.4 million has been appropriated for such purpose for fiscal year 2008-09. Fund assets do not constitute plan assets for purposes of GASB Statements Nos. 43 and 45 and for actuarial valuation purposes fund assets are not treated as valuation assets available to offset the accrued liability of the plan. It is anticipated that significant General Fund appropriations will be required for each fiscal year to meet retiree health insurance costs. Legislation which became effective July 1, 1998 generally requires the State to subsidize the health insurance costs of retired teachers who are not members of the Teachers’ Retirement Board’s health benefit plan in a manner consistent with its prior practice of subsidizing the health insurance costs of those retired teachers who were members of the Board’s health benefit plan. Legislation which became effective July 1, 2008 generally requires the State to subsidize a portion of the health insurance costs of retired teachers who have attained normal retirement age, are ineligible to participate in Medicare Part A and pay to participate in local board of education retiree health benefit plans. Since July 1, 1994, retiree health benefits have been self-insured.

Implementation of GASB Statement No. 45 requires the State to obtain an analysis of the unfunded actuarial accrued liability of such retiree health insurance benefits and to recognize the annual required contribution to fund that actuarial liability in its financial statements commencing with those for fiscal year 2007-08. The Teachers’ Retirement Board has received an actuarial valuation of the State’s liability with respect to postretirement health care benefits for members of the Teachers’ Retirement Fund. The report indicates an actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2008 of $2,318.8 million on an unfunded basis, based upon certain stated assumptions including a 4.5% earnings assumption and a 30 year amortization period and no valuation assets available to offset the liabilities of the plan. The actuarial valuation determined a $116.7 million employer contribution requirement for fiscal year 2008-09 and $121.3 million for fiscal year 2009-10, based on an individual entry-age actuarial cost method and level percent-of-payroll contributions. The State paid $20.7 million for post-retirement health insurance costs for fiscal year 2007-08. The valuation noted that if the plan were prefunded the actuarial accrued liability as of June 30, 2008 would be reduced to $1.52 billion based on a 7.5% earnings assumption, which would result in a $67.9 million employer contribution requirement for fiscal year 2008-09.

 

D-18


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX E — LEGACY COLUMBIA FUNDS

Legacy Columbia funds are funds that were branded Columbia or Columbia Acorn prior to Sept. 27, 2010.

 

ColumbiaSM Acorn® Fund

ColumbiaSM Acorn International®

ColumbiaSM Acorn International Select®

ColumbiaSM Acorn Select®

ColumbiaSM Acorn USA®

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Columbia Balanced Fund

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Columbia Bond Fund

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Columbia Core Bond Fund

Columbia Corporate Income Fund (formerly known as Columbia Income Fund)

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund

Columbia Federal Securities Fund

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Global Value Fund

Columbia Greater China Fund

Columbia High Income Fund

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia International Bond Fund

Columbia International Growth Fund

Columbia International Stock Fund

Columbia International Value Fund

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Columbia Liberty Fund

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

 

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

Columbia Select Small Cap Fund

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Technology Fund

ColumbiaSM Thermostat Fund®

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia World Equity Fund

 

E-1


Table of Contents

 

APPENDIX F — LEGACY RIVERSOURCE FUNDS

Legacy RiverSource funds include RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds, funds renamed effective Sept. 27, 2010 to bear the Columbia brand, and certain other funds. Prior fund names are noted in parenthesis.

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund)

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund)

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Tax-Exempt Bond Fund)

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Asia Pacific Fund)

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Bond Fund)

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Equity Income Fund)

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Dividend Opportunity Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Emerging Markets Bond Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund)

Columbia Equity Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Equity Value Fund)

Columbia European Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle European Equity Fund)

Columbia Floating Rate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Floating Rate Fund)

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Frontier Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Global Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Global Bond Fund)

Columbia Global Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Global Equity Fund)

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund (RiverSource Global Extended Alpha Fund)

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc. (formerly known as RiverSource Government Money Market Fund, Inc.)

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource High Yield Bond Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Basic Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund II (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Moderate Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund III (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Enhanced Income Fund)

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Opportunities Fund)

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Inflation Protected Securities Fund)

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Equity Fund)

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Limited Duration Bond Fund)

Columbia Marsico Flexible Capital Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund)

Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Cash Management Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners International Select Value Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund)

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund)

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Recovery and Infrastructure Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2010 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2015 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2020 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2025 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2030 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2035 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2040 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2045 Fund)

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Large-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund (formerly known as Seligman Global Technology Fund)

Columbia Short-Term Cash Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund)

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Strategic Allocation Fund)

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund (formerly known as RiverSource U.S. Government Mortgage Fund)

RiverSource Balanced Fund

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

Seligman California Municipal High Yield Series

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

Seligman National Municipal Class

Seligman New York Municipal Class

Seligman TargETFund 2015

Seligman TargETFund 2025

Seligman TargETFund 2035

Seligman TargETFund 2045

Seligman TargETFund Core

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

Appendix C Statement of Additional Information of Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Oct. 29, 2010

 

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc.

  

Class A: SLFRX

   Class B: SLFBX    Class C: SLFCX

Class I: —

   Class R: SFFRX    Class R4: SFFTX

Class R5: SFFIX

   Class Z: CFOZX   

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc.

Class A: SCMXX

   Class B: SCBXX    Class C: SCCXX

Class R: SMRXX

   Class R5: SMIXX    Class Z: CGZXX

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.

Class A: SLMCX

   Class B: SLMBX    Class C: SCICX

Class I: —

   Class R: SCIRX    Class R3: SCIOX

Class R4: SCIFX

   Class R5: SCMIX    Class Z: CCIZX

RiverSource Bond Series, Inc.

Columbia Floating Rate Fund

Class A: RFRAX

   Class B: RSFBX    Class C: RFRCX

Class I: RFRIX

   Class R: CFRRX    Class R4: —

Class R5: RFRFX

   Class W: RFRWX    Class Z: CFRZX

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund

Class A: AIOAX

   Class B: AIOBX    Class C: RIOCX

Class I: AOPIX

   Class R: CIORX    Class R4: —

Class W: CIOWX

   Class Z: CIOZX   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

Class A: APSAX

   Class B: APSBX    Class C: RIPCX

Class I: AIPIX

   Class R: RIPRX    Class R4: —

Class W: RIPWX

   Class Z: CIPZX   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund

Class A: ALDAX

   Class B: ALDBX    Class C: RDCLX

Class I: ALDIX

   Class R4: —    Class W: RLDWX

Class Z: CLDZX

     

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Trust

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

Class A: ICALX

   Class B: ACABX    Class C: RCTCX

RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc.

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

Class A: RDSAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RDSCX

Class I: RDSIX

   Class R4: —    Class W: RSDVX

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

Class A: RDVAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RDVCX

Class I: RCVIX

   Class R: —    Class R3: —

RiverSource Diversified Income Series, Inc.

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund

Class A: INBNX

   Class B: ININX    Class C: AXBCX

Class I: RDBIX

   Class R: —    Class R3: RSDBX

Class R4: IDBYX

   Class R5: RSVBX    Class W: RVBWX

Class Z: CDBZX

     

RiverSource Equity Series, Inc.

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund

Class A: INVPX

   Class B: IDQBX    Class C: AESCX

Class I: AQUIX

   Class R: —    Class R3: —

Class R4: IESYX

   Class Z: CVOZX   

RiverSource Global Series, Inc.

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

Class A: RARAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RARCX

Class I: RVAIX

   Class W: RACWX    Class Z: CACZX

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund

Class A: REBAX

   Class B: —    Class C: REBCX

Class I: RSMIX

   Class R4: —    Class W: REMWX

Class Z: CMBZX

     

Columbia Global Bond Fund

Class A: IGBFX

   Class B: IGLOX    Class C: AGBCX

Class I: AGBIX

   Class R: —    Class R4: RGBRX

Class W: RGBWX

   Class Z: CGBZX   

 

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund

Class A: IDEAX

   Class B: IEMBX    Class C: RMCEX

Class I: RSRIX

   Class R: REMRX    Class R4: —

Class R5: REMFX

   Class W: CMOWX    Class Z: CEOZX

Columbia Global Equity Fund

Class A: IGIGX

   Class B: IDGBX    Class C: RGCEX

Class I: —

   Class R: —    Class R4: IDGYX

Class R5: RGERX

   Class W: —    Class Z: CGEZX

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund

Class A: RTAAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RTACX

Class I: —

   Class R: REAOX    Class R4: REYRX

Class Z: CEAZX

     

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

Class A: RTNAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RTNEX

Class I: —

   Class R: RGEOX    Class R4: RGEYX

RiverSource Government Income Series, Inc.

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund

Class A: AUGAX

   Class B: AUGBX    Class C: AUGCX

Class I: RVGIX

   Class R4: RSGYX    Class Z: CUGZX

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

Class A: IFINX

   Class B: ISHOX    Class C: AXFCX

Class I: AGMIX

   Class R: RSDRX    Class R4: IDFYX

Class W: RSDWX

     

RiverSource High Yield Income Series, Inc.

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund

Class A: INEAX

   Class B: IEIBX    Class C: APECX

Class I: RSHIX

   Class R: —    Class R3: —

Class R4: RSHYX

   Class R5: RSHRX    Class W: RHYWX

Class Z: CHYZX

     

RiverSource Income Series, Inc.

Columbia Income Builder Fund

Class A: RBBAX

   Class B: RBBBX    Class C: RBBCX

Class R4: —

   Class R: CBURX    Class Z: CBUZX

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

Class A: RSMAX

   Class B: RSMBX    Class C: RSMCX

Class R4: —

     

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

Class A: RSBAX

   Class B: REIVX    Class C: RIECX

Class R4: —

     

RiverSource International Managers Series, Inc.

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund

Class A: APIAX

   Class B: AXIBX    Class C: APICX

Class I: APRIX

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CMVZX

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

Class A: AXGAX

   Class B: APIBX    Class C: RIACX

Class I: AIGGX

   Class R: RISRX    Class R4: —

Class R5: RISSX

     

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

Class A: AISCX

   Class B: APNBX    Class C: RISLX

Class I: RPSCX

   Class R: —    Class R4: —

Class R5: —

     

RiverSource International Series, Inc.

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund

Class A: CAJAX

   Class C: CAJCX    Class R: CAJRX

Class R5: TAPRX

   Class Z: CAJZX   

Columbia European Equity Fund

Class A: AXEAX

   Class B: AEEBX    Class C: REECX

Class I: —

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CEEZX

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

Class A: RDIAX

   Class B: RDIBX    Class C: RDICX

Class I: RSDIX

   Class R: RDIOX    Class R4: RDIRX

Class W: RDIWX

     


Table of Contents

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

Class A: INIFX

   Class B: IWWGX    Class C: ROPCX

Class I: ATNIX

   Class R: —    Class R4: IDIYX

RiverSource Investment Series, Inc.

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund

Class A: INDZX

   Class B: IDEBX    Class C: ADECX

Class I: ADIIX

   Class R: RDEIX    Class R3: RDERX

Class R4: IDQYX

   Class R5: RSEDX    Class W: —

Class Z: CDVZX

     

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund

Class A: RDLAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RDLCX

Class I: RDLIX

   Class R: —    Class R4: RDLFX

Class W: RDLWX

   Class Z: CLQZX   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

Class A: RLCAX

   Class B: —    Class C: RDCCX

Class I: —

   Class R: RLCOX    Class R4: RLCYX

Class W: RLCWX

   Class Z: CVQZX   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund

Class A: AMVAX

   Class B: AMVBX    Class C: AMVCX

Class I: RMCIX

   Class R: RMVTX    Class R3: RMCRX

Class R4: RMCVX

   Class R5: RSCMX    Class W: —

Class Z: CMOZX

     

RiverSource Balanced Fund

Class A: INMUX

   Class B: IDMBX    Class C: RVBCX

Class R: RVBRX

   Class R4: IDMYX    Class R5: RVBSX

RiverSource Large Cap Series, Inc.

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund

Class A: AQEAX

   Class B: AQEBX    Class C: RDCEX

Class I: ALEIX

   Class R: —    Class R4: RQEYX

Class R5: RSIPX

   Class W: RDEWX    Class Z: CCRZX

RiverSource Managers Series, Inc.

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund

Class A: ASVAX

   Class B: ASVBX    Class C: APVCX

Class I: —

   Class R: RSVTX    Class R3: RSVRX

Class R4: RSGLX

   Class R5: RSCVX    Class Z: CMAZX

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

Class A: AFVAX

   Class B: AFVBX    Class C: AFVCX

Class I: AFVIX

   Class R4: —   

RiverSource Market Advantage Series, Inc.

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund

Class A: AXBAX

   Class B: AXPBX    Class C: RBGCX

Class R: CPARX

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CPAZX

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund

Class A: ABDAX

   Class B: ABBDX    Class C: RPCCX

Class R: CBURX

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CBVZX

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund

Class A: AXMAX

   Class B: ABMBX    Class C: AGECX

Class R: CBARX

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CBAZX

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund

Class A: AUCAX

   Class B: AMDBX    Class C: RBMCX

Class R: CPMRX

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CPMZX

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund

Class A: ABUAX

   Class B: AURBX    Class C: AMTCX

Class R: CBMRX

   Class R4: —    Class Z: CBMZX

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund

Class A: AXTAX

   Class B: AXTBX    Class C: RBTCX

Class R4: —

     

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

Class A: ADIDX

   Class Z: ADIEX   

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

Class A: ISIAX

   Class B: ISIBX    Class R4: ISCYX

 

RiverSource Money Market Series, Inc.

Columbia Money Market Fund

Class A: IDSXX

   Class B: ACBXX    Class C: RCCXX

Class I: RCIXX

   Class R: RVRXX    Class R5: —

Class W: RCWXX

   Class Z: IDYXX   

RiverSource Sector Series, Inc.

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund

Class A: INUTX

   Class B: IUTBX    Class C: ACUIX

Class I: RSOIX

   Class R: RSOOX    Class R4: RSORX

Class R5: RSDFX

   Class W: —    Class Z: CDOZX

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

Class A: ARLAX

   Class B: AESBX    Class C: RRECX

Class I: AESIX

   Class R4: —    Class W: RREWX

RiverSource Selected Series, Inc.

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

Class A: INPMX

   Class B: INPBX    Class C: RPMCX

Class I: —

   Class R4: AEVYX   

RiverSource Series Trust

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund

Class A: RCEAX

   Class B: RZZBX    Class C: RECCX

Class I: —

   Class Z: CCEZX   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund

Class A: RRIAX

   Class B: RRIBX    Class C: RRICX

Class I: RRIIX

   Class R: RRIRX    Class R4: RRIYX

Class R5: RRIZX

   Class Z: CRIZX   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRTCX    Class R: —

Class Y: RSSPX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRPCX    Class R: —

Class Y: RSFNX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRUCX    Class R: —

Class Y: RSNFX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRLCX    Class R: —

Class Y: RSMEX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRRCX    Class R: —

Class Y: RPTYX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRPZX    Class R: —

Class Y: RPOYX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRWCX    Class R: —

Class Y: RPFYX

     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund

Class A: —

   Class C: CRFCX    Class R: —

Class R4: RSNNX

   Class Y: RRPYX   

RiverSource Special Tax-Exempt Series Trust

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund

Class A: IMNTX

   Class B: IDSMX    Class C: RMTCX

Class Z: CMNZX

     

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

Class A: INYKX

   Class B: —    Class C: RNTCX

RiverSource Strategic Allocation Series, Inc.

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund

Class A: IMRFX

   Class B: IMRBX    Class C: RSSCX

Class I: —

   Class R: —    Class R4: IDRYX

Class Z: CSAZX

     

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

Class A: RSGAX

   Class B: RIABX    Class C: RAICX

Class R: RSDOX

   Class R4: RSTRX    Class R5: RSFRX


Table of Contents

 

RiverSource Strategy Series, Inc.

Columbia Equity Value Fund

Class A: IEVAX

   Class B: INEGX    Class C: REVCX

Class I: —

   Class R: REVRX    Class R3: RSEVX

Class R4: AEVYX

   Class R5: RSEYX    Class W: —

Class Z: CEVZX

     

RiverSource Tax-Exempt Income Series, Inc.

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

Class A: INHYX

   Class B: IHYBX    Class C: AHECX

RiverSource Tax-Exempt Series, Inc.

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund

Class A: INTAX

   Class B: ITEBX    Class C: RTCEX

Class Z: CATZX

     

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

Class A: INFAX

   Class B: INFBX    Class C: RTICX

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

Class A: SCFIX

   Class B: SLCBX    Class C: SCLCX

Class I: —

   Class R: SCFRX    Class R5: SCLIX

Seligman Global Fund Series, Inc.

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund

Class A: SHGTX

   Class B: SHTBX    Class C: SHTCX

Class I: —

   Class R: SGTRX    Class R4: SGTSX

Class R5: SGTTX

   Class Z: CSGZX   

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

Class A: SGRFX

   Class B: SGBTX    Class C: SGRCX

Class I: —

   Class R: SGRFX    Class R4: SGRSX

Class R5: SGFIX

     

Seligman LaSalle Real Estate Fund Series, Inc.

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

Class A: SLDAX

   Class C: SLDCX    Class I: —

Class R: SLDRX

   Class R4: SLDTX    Class R5: SLDIX

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

Class A: SREAX

   Class B: SREBX    Class C: SRECX

Class I: —

   Class R: SRERX    Class R4: SLRCX

Class R5: SREIX

     

Seligman Municipal Fund Series, Inc.

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

Class A: SMNNX

   Class C: SMNCX   

Seligman National Municipal Class

Class A: SNXEX

   Class C: SNACX   

Seligman New York Municipal Class

Class A: SNYTX

   Class C: SNYCX   

Seligman Municipal Series Trust

Seligman California Municipal High Yield Series

Class A: SCHYX

   Class C: SCHCX   

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

Class A: SCTQX

   Class C: SCQCX   

Seligman TargetHorizon ETF Portfolios, Inc.

Seligman TargETFund 2015*

Class A: STJAX

   Class B: —    Class C: STJCX

Class R: STJRX

   Class R5: STJIX   

Seligman TargETFund 2025*

Class A: STKAX

   Class B: —    Class C: STKCX

Class R: STKRX

   Class R5: STKIX   

Seligman TargETFund 2035*

Class A: STZAX

   Class B: —    Class C: STZCX

Class R: STZRX

   Class R5: STZIX   

Seligman TargETFund 2045*

Class A: STQAX

   Class B: —    Class C: STQCX

Class R: STQRX

   Class R5: STQIX   

Seligman TargETFund Core*

Class A: SHVAX

   Class B: —    Class C: SHVCX

Class R: SHVRX

   Class R5: SHVIX   

Seligman Value Fund Series, Inc.

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund

Class A: SLVAX

   Class B: SLVBX    Class C: SLVCX

Class I: —

   Class R: SLVRX    Class R4: SLVTX

Class R5: SLVIX

   Class W: CSVWX    Class Z: CSVZX

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund

Class A: SSCVX

   Class B: SSCBX    Class C: SVMCX

Class I: —

   Class R: SSVRX    Class R4: SSLRX

Class R5: SSVIX

   Class Z: CSSZX   

 

* Effective May 28, 2010 the funds are no longer open to new investors. All outstanding shares of each fund are anticipated to be redeemed on or about Nov. 30, 2010.

This is the Statement of Additional Information (“SAI”) for each of the funds listed on the previous pages. This SAI is not a prospectus. It should be read together with the appropriate current fund prospectus, the date of which can be found in Table 1 of this SAI.

Each fund’s financial statements for its most recent fiscal period are contained in the fund’s annual or semiannual report to shareholders. The Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s Report and the Financial Statements, including Notes to the Financial Statements and the Schedule of Investments in Securities and any applicable Schedule of Affiliated Funds, contained in the Annual Report, are incorporated in this SAI by reference. No other portion of the Annual Report is incorporated by reference. For a free copy of a fund prospectus, annual or semiannual report, contact your financial intermediary (or selling/servicing agent) or write to the family of funds, which includes Columbia, RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle branded funds (collectively, the “Fund Family”), at c/o Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., P.O. Box 8081, Boston, MA 02266-8081, call 800.345.6611 or visit columbiamanagement.com.

Each fund is governed by a Board of Directors/Trustees (the “Board”) that meets regularly to review a wide variety of matters affecting the funds. Detailed information about fund governance, the funds’ investment manager, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (the “investment manager” or “Columbia Management”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (“Ameriprise Financial”), and other aspects of fund management can be found by referencing the Table of Contents or the List of Tables on the following pages.


Table of Contents

 

Table of Contents

 

Fundamental and Nonfundamental Investment Policies

     5   

Investment Strategies and Types of Investments

     13   

Information Regarding Risks and Investment Strategies

     15   

Securities Transactions

     43   

Brokerage Commissions Paid to Brokers Affiliated with the Investment Manager

     57   

Valuing Fund Shares

     62   

Portfolio Holdings Disclosure

     74   

Proxy Voting

     77   

Investing in a Fund

     79   

Selling Shares

     86   

Pay-out Plans

     87   

Capital Loss Carryover

     88   

Taxes

     91   

Service Providers

     97   

Investment Management Services

     97   

Administrative Services

     146   

Transfer Agency Services

     151   

Plan Administration Services

     151   

Distribution Services

     151   

Plan and Agreement of Distribution

     155   

Payments to Financial Intermediaries

     160   

Custodian Services

     162   

Board Services Corporation

     163   

Organizational Information

     163   

Board Members and Officers

     170   

Control Persons and Principal Holders of Securities

     188   

Information Regarding Pending and Settled Legal Proceedings

     213   

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     214   

Appendix A: Description of Ratings

     A-1  

Appendix B: State Risk Factors

     B-1   

Appendix C: Additional Information about the S&P 500 Index

     C-1   

Appendix D: Class A — Calculation of the Sales Charge

     D-1   

Appendix E: Legacy Columbia Funds

     E-1   

Appendix F: Legacy RiverSource Funds

     F-1   

Statement of Additional Information – Oct. 29, 2010

 

1


Table of Contents

 

List of Tables

 

1.

   Fund Fiscal Year Ends, Prospectus Date and Investment Categories      3   

2.

   Fundamental Policies      5   

3.

   Investment Strategies and Types of Investments      13   

4.

   Total Brokerage Commissions      45   

5.

   Brokerage Directed for Research, and Turnover Rates      48   

6.

   Securities of Regular Brokers or Dealers      51   

7.

   Brokerage Commissions Paid to Investment Manager or Affiliates      57   

8.

   Valuing Fund Shares      62   

9.

   Class A — Initial Sales Charge      79   

10.

   Public Offering Price      80   

11.

   Capital Loss Carryover      88   

12.

   Corporate Deduction and Qualified Dividend Income      93   

13.

   Investment Management Services Agreement Fee Schedule      97   

14.

   PIA Indexes      106   

15A.

   Performance Incentive Adjustment Calculation      107   

15B.

   Performance Incentive Adjustment Calculation      108   

16.

   Management Fees and Nonadvisory Expenses      109   

17.

   Subadvisers and Subadvisory Agreement Fee Schedules      113   

18.

   Subadvisory Fees      115   

19.

   Portfolio Managers      116   

20.

   Administrative Services Agreement Fee Schedule      146   

21.

   Administrative Fees      148   

22.

   Sales Charges Paid to Distributor      151   

23.

   12b-1 Fees      156   

24.

   Unreimbursed Distribution Expenses      159   

25.

   Fund History Table      164   

26.

   Board Members      170   

27.

   Fund Officers      172   

28.

   Committee Meetings      175   

29.

   Board Member Holdings      176   

30.

   Board Member Compensation — All Funds      181   

31.

   Board Member Compensation — Individual Funds      182   

32.

   Control Persons and Principal Holders of Securities      188   

 

2


Table of Contents

 

Table 1. Fund Fiscal Year Ends, Prospectus Date and Investment Categories

 

Fund

   Fiscal Year End   Prospectus Date   

Fund Investment Category

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Equity

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Taxable fixed income*

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

   November 30   Jan. 29, 2010    Tax-exempt fixed income

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Diversified Bond

   August 31   Oct. 29, 2010    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   September 30   Nov. 27, 2009    Equity

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   June 30   Aug. 27, 2010    Equity

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Equity Value

   March 31   May 28, 2010    Equity

Columbia European Equity

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Floating Rate

   July 31   Sept. 27, 2010    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Frontier

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Global Bond

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Global Equity

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Government Money Market

   December 31   March 1, 2010    Taxable Money Market

Columbia High Yield Bond

   May 31   July 30, 2010    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   January 31**   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – fixed income

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

   January 31**   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – fixed income

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

   January 31**   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – fixed income

Columbia Income Opportunities

   July 31   Sept. 27, 2010    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

   July 31   Sept. 27, 2010    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Equity

   July 31   Sept. 27, 2010    Equity

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

   September 30   Nov. 27, 2009    Equity

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

   September 30   Nov. 27, 2009    Equity

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

   July 31   Sept. 27, 2010    Taxable fixed income

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

   November 30   Jan. 22, 2010    Equity

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

   September 30   Nov. 27, 2009    Equity

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

   August 31   Oct. 29, 2010    State tax-exempt fixed income

Columbia Money Market

   July 31   Sept. 27, 2010    Taxable money market

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   May 31   July 30, 2010    Equity

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

   January 31   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

   January 31   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – fixed income

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

   January 31   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

   January 31   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

   January 31   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – fixed income

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

   January 31   April 1, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

   April 30   June 29, 2010    Fund-of-funds – equity

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

   December 31   March 1, 2010    Equity

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

   December 31   March 1, 2010    Equity

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

   December 31   March 1, 2010    Equity

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

   October 31   Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

 

3


Table of Contents

Fund

   Fiscal Year End    Prospectus Date   

Fund Investment Category

Columbia Strategic Allocation

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Balanced

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

   May 31    July 30, 2010    Taxable fixed income

RiverSource Balanced

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Balanced

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

   August 31    Oct. 29, 2010    State tax-exempt fixed income

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

   October 31    Dec. 30, 2008    Equity

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

   July 31    Sept. 27, 2010    Equity

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

   July 31    Sept. 27, 2010    Equity

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

   November 30    Jan. 29, 2010    Tax-exempt fixed income

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

   December 31    March 1, 2010    Equity

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

   December 31    March 1, 2010    Equity

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

   August 31    Oct. 29, 2010    State tax-exempt fixed income

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   May 31    July 30, 2010    Equity

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   October 31    Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   October 31    Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

   March 31    May 28, 2010    Equity

RiverSource Real Estate

   June 30    Aug. 27, 2010    Equity

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

   January 31    April 1, 2010    Equity

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

   May 31    July 30, 2010    Taxable fixed income

RiverSource Small Company Index

   January 31    April 1, 2010    Equity

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Taxable fixed income*

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

   November 30    Jan. 29, 2010    Tax-exempt fixed income

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    State tax-exempt fixed income

Seligman California Municipal Quality

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    State tax-exempt fixed income

Seligman Capital

   December 31    March 1, 2010    Equity

Seligman Growth

   December 31    March 1, 2010    Equity

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    State tax-exempt fixed income

Seligman National Municipal

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Tax-exempt fixed income

Seligman New York Municipal

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    State tax-exempt fixed income

Seligman TargETFund 2015

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Fund-of-funds – equity

Seligman TargETFund 2025

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Fund-of-funds – equity

Seligman TargETFund 2035

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Fund-of-funds – equity

Seligman TargETFund 2045

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Fund-of-funds – equity

Seligman TargETFund Core

   September 30    Nov. 27, 2009    Fund-of-funds – equity

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

   October 31    Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   October 31    Dec. 30, 2009    Equity

 

* The taxable fixed income fund investment category includes Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund, which is an alternative investment strategy. Although RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund is a taxable fixed income fund, it may invest up to 10% of its portfolio in equity securities.
** The fund changed its fiscal year end effective Jan. 31, 2008 from May 31 to Jan. 31. For 2008, the information shown is for the period from June 1, 2007 to Jan. 31, 2008. For years prior to 2008, the fiscal period ended May 31.

 

4


Table of Contents

 

Fundamental and Nonfundamental Investment Policies

Fundamental investment policies adopted by a fund cannot be changed without the approval of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the fund (i.e., shareholders) as defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”). Nonfundamental investment policies may be changed by the Board at any time.

Notwithstanding any of a fund’s other investment policies, each fund, subject to certain limitations, may invest its assets in an open-end management investment company having substantially the same investment objectives, policies, and restrictions as the fund for the purpose of having those assets managed as part of a combined pool.

FUNDAMENTAL POLICIES

Fundamental policies are policies that can be changed only with shareholder approval. The chart below shows fund-specific policies that may be changed only with shareholder approval. The chart indicates whether or not the fund has a policy on a particular topic. A dash indicates that the fund does not have a policy on a particular topic. Please see “Investment Strategies and Types of Investments” for more information regarding your fund’s investment strategies. The specific policy is stated in the paragraphs that follow the table.

Table 2. Fundamental Policies

 

Fund

  A
Buy or
sell  real

estate
    B
Buy or sell
commodities
    C
Buy more
than 10% of
an issuer
    D
Invest
more than
5% in an
issuer
    E
Concentrate

in any one
industry
    F
Invest less
than 80%
    G
Act as an
underwriter
    H
Lending
    I
Borrow
money
    J
Issue
senior
securities
    K
Buy on
margin/sell
short
 

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

    A1        B4        C1        D1        E8        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

    A1        B1        —          —          E7        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

    A1        B1        C1        D1        —          F3 (a)      G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

    A1        B2        C2        C2        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Diversified Bond

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

    A1        B1        C1        D1        —          —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

    A1        B3        —          —          E5        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Equity Value

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia European Equity

    A1        B1        —          —          E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Floating Rate

    A1        B3        C1        D1        E6        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Global Bond

    A1        B1        C1        —          E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Global Equity

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

    A1        B2        C2        C2        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Government Money Market

    A6        —          C4        C4        E11        —          G3        H5        J3        J3        G3   

Columbia High Yield Bond

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Income Builder Fund*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Income Builder Fund II*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Income Builder Fund III*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Income Opportunities

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

    A1        B1        —          —          E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

    A1        B2        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

    A1        B2        C2        C2        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

    A1        B1        —          —          —          F1        G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Money Market

    A2        A2        C1        D1        —          —          G1        H1        I1        J1        K1   

 

5


Table of Contents

Fund

  A
Buy or
sell  real

estate
    B
Buy or sell
commodities
    C
Buy more
than 10% of
an issuer
    D
Invest
more than
5% in an
issuer
    E
Concentrate

in any one
industry
    F
Invest less
than 80%
    G
Act as an
underwriter
    H
Lending
    I
Borrow
money
    J
Issue
senior
securities
    K
Buy on
margin/sell
short
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

    A1        B2        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

    A1        B2        —          —          E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive*

    A1        B1        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative*

    A1        B1        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate*

    A1        B1        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive*

    A1        B1        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative*

    A1        B1        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity*

    A1        B1        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

    A1        B3        —          —          E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045*

    A1        B3        C2        C2        E2        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E13        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Balanced

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

    A1        B1        —          —          —          F1        G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

    A1        B3        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

    A1        B3        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

    A1        B3        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

    A1        B1        C1        D1        —          F3 (b)      G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

    A7        B6        —          —          E12        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

    A7        B6        —          —          E12        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

    A1        B1        —          —          —          F1        G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

    A1        B2        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

    A1        B2        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

    A1        B2        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

    A1        B1 (c)      —          —          E3        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Real Estate

    A1        B1        —          —          —          —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

    A1        B1        —          —          E4        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Small Company Index

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

    A1        B2        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

    A1        B1        C1        D1        —          F2        G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

 

6


Table of Contents

Fund

  A
Buy or
sell  real

estate
    B
Buy or sell
commodities
    C
Buy more
than 10% of
an issuer
    D
Invest
more than
5% in an
issuer
    E
Concentrate

in any one
industry
    F
Invest less
than 80%
    G
Act as an
underwriter
    H
Lending
    I
Borrow
money
    J
Issue
senior
securities
    K
Buy on
margin/sell
short
 

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

    A3        B5 (d)      D2        D2        E9        F4        G1        H2        I2        —          K2 (e) 

Seligman California Municipal Quality

    A3        B5 (d)      D2        D2        E9        F4        G1        H2        I2        —          K2 (e) 

Seligman Capital

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman Frontier

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman Growth

    A3        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

    A4        B5        D2        D2        E9        F4        G1        H3        I2        —          K2   

Seligman National Municipal

    A4        B5        D2        D2        E9        F4        G1        H3        I2        —          K2   

Seligman New York Municipal

    A4        B5        D2        D2        E9        F4        G1        H3        I2        —          K2   

Seligman TargETFund 2015*

    A5        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman TargETFund 2025*

    A5        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman TargETFund 2035*

    A5        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman TargETFund 2045*

    A5        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Seligman TargETFund Core*

    A5        B6        C3        C3        E10        —          G2        H4        J2        J2        K3   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

    A1        B2        C2        C2        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

Threadneedle International Opportunity

    A1        B1        C1        D1        E1        —          G1        H1        I1        J1        —     

 

* The fund-of-funds invests in a combination of underlying funds. These underlying funds have adopted their own investment policies that may be more or less restrictive than those of the fund-of-funds. The policies of the underlying funds may permit a fund to engage in investment strategies indirectly that would otherwise be prohibited under the fund’s investment restrictions.
(a) The fund does not intend to purchase bonds or other debt securities the interest from which is subject to the alternative minimum tax.
(b) For purposes of this policy, the fund will not include any investments subject to the alternative minimum tax.
(c) Additionally, the fund may purchase gold, silver, or other precious metals, strategic metals or other metals occurring naturally with such metals.
(d) The policy includes futures contracts.
(e) A fund may be deemed an underwriter in connection with the purchase and sale of portfolio securities.

A. Buy or sell real estate

 

  A1 – The fund will not buy or sell real estate, unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from investing in securities or other instruments backed by real estate or securities of companies engaged in the real estate business or real estate investment trusts. For purposes of this policy, real estate includes real estate limited partnerships.

 

  A2 – The fund will not buy or sell real estate, commodities or commodity contracts. For purposes of this policy, real estate includes real estate limited partnerships.

 

  A3 – The fund will not purchase or hold any real estate, except that a fund may invest in securities secured by real estate or interests therein or issued by persons (other than real estate investment trusts) which deal in real estate or interests therein.

 

  A4 – The fund will not purchase or hold any real estate, including limited partnership interests on real property, except that the fund may invest in securities secured by real estate or interests therein or issued by persons (other than real estate investment trusts) which deal in real estate or interests therein.

 

  A5 – The fund will not purchase or hold any real estate, except a fund may invest (through investments in Underlying exchange-traded funds) in securities secured by real estate or interests therein or issued by persons (including real estate investment trusts) which deal in real estate or interests therein.

 

  A6 – The fund will not buy or hold any real estate or securities of corporations or trusts whose principal business is investing in interests in real estate.

 

  A7 – The fund will not purchase or hold any real estate, except that the fund may (A) invest in (i) securities directly or indirectly secured by real estate or interests therein or issued by companies which invest in real estate or interests therein or (ii) securities of issuers that deal in real estate or are engaged in the real estate business, including but not limited to real estate investment trusts (and, in the case of RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate, RiverSource Global Real Estate Companies, as defined in the fund’s prospectus), and (B) hold and sell real estate acquired through default, liquidation, or other distributions of an interest in real estate as a result of a fund’s ownership of such securities.

 

7


Table of Contents

 

B. Buy or sell physical commodities

 

  B1 – The fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from buying or selling options and futures contracts or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.

 

  B2 – The fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from buying or selling options, futures contracts and foreign currency or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.

 

  B3 – The fund will not buy or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except this shall not prevent the fund from buying or selling options, futures contracts and foreign currency or from entering into forward currency contracts or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by, or whose value is derived from, physical commodities.

 

  B4 – The fund will not buy or sell commodities, except that the fund may to the extent consistent with its investment objective(s), invest in securities of companies that purchase or sell commodities or which invest in such programs, and purchase and sell options, forward contracts, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts and enter into swap contracts and other financial transactions relating to commodities. This restriction does not apply to foreign currency transactions including without limitation forward currency contracts.

 

  B5 – The fund will not purchase or sell commodities or commodity contracts.

 

  B6 – The fund will not purchase or sell commodities or commodity contracts, except to the extent permissible under applicable law and interpretations, as they may be amended from time to time.

C. Buy more than 10% of an issuer

 

  C1 – The fund will not purchase more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of an issuer, except that up to 25% of the fund’s assets may be invested without regard to this 10% limitation. For tax-exempt funds, for purposes of this policy, the terms of a municipal security determine the issuer.

 

  C2 – The fund will not purchase securities (except securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities) of any one issuer if, as a result, more than 5% of its total assets will be invested in the securities of such issuer or it would own more than 10% of the voting securities of such issuer, except that: (a) up to 25% of its total assets may be invested without regard to these limitations; and (b) a fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, or any applicable exemptive relief.

 

  C3 – The fund will not make any investment inconsistent with its classification as a diversified company under the 1940 Act.

 

  C4 – The fund will not invest more than 5% of its gross assets (taken at market) in the securities of any one issuer, other than the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities, or buy more than 10% of the voting securities of any one issuer, other than U.S. Government agencies or instrumentalities.

D. Invest more than 5% in an issuer

 

  D1 – The fund will not invest more than 5% of its total assets in securities of any company, government, or political subdivision thereof, except the limitation will not apply to investments in securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities, or other investment companies, and except that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets may be invested without regard to this 5% limitation. For tax-exempt funds, for purposes of this policy, the terms of a municipal security determine the issuer.

 

  D2 – The fund will not, as to 50% of the value of its total assets, purchase securities of any issuer if immediately thereafter more than 5% of total assets at market value would be invested in the securities of any issuer (except that this limitation does not apply to obligations issued or guaranteed as to principal and interest by the U.S. Government or its agencies or instrumentalities).

E. Concentrate

 

  E1 – The fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), this means that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.

 

  E2 –

The fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the SEC, this means that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any

 

8


Table of Contents
 

one industry. The fund itself does not intend to concentrate, however, the aggregation of holdings of the underlying funds may result in the fund indirectly investing more than 25% of its assets in a particular industry. The fund does not control the investments of the underlying funds and any indirect concentration will occur only as a result of the fund following its investment objectives by investing in the underlying funds.

 

  E3 – The fund will not invest less than 25% of its total assets in the precious metals industry, based on current market value at the time of purchase, unless market conditions temporarily require a defensive investment strategy.

 

  E4 – The fund will not concentrate in any one industry unless that industry represents more than 25% of the index tracked by the fund. For all other industries, in accordance with the current interpretation by the SEC, this means that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.

 

  E5 – While the fund may invest 25% or more of its total assets in the securities of foreign governmental and corporate entities located in the same country, it will not invest 25% or more of its total assets in any single foreign governmental issuer.

 

  E6 – The fund will not concentrate in any one industry. According to the present interpretation by the SEC, this means that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets, based on current market value at time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry. For purposes of this restriction, loans will be considered investments in the industry of the underlying borrower, rather than that of the seller of the loan.

 

  E7 – The fund will not concentrate in any one industry, provided however, that this restriction shall not apply to securities or obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, banks or bank holding companies or finance companies. For all other industries, this means that up to 25% of the fund’s total assets, based on current market value at the time of purchase, can be invested in any one industry.

 

  E8 – The fund will not purchase any securities which would cause 25% or more of the value of its total assets at the time of purchase to be invested in the securities of one or more issuers conducting their principal business activities in the same industry, provided that: a) there is no limitation with respect to obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, any state or territory of the United States, or any of their agencies, instrumentalities or political subdivisions; and b) notwithstanding this limitation or any other fundamental investment limitation, assets may be invested in the securities of one or more management investment companies to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

 

  E9 – The fund will not invest more than 25% of total assets, at market value, in any one industry; except that municipal securities and securities of the U.S. Government, its agencies and instrumentalities are not considered an industry for purposes of this limitation.

 

  E10 – The fund will not invest 25% or more of its total assets, at market value, in the securities of issuers in any particular industry, provided that this limitation shall exclude securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or any of its agencies or instrumentalities (which, for Seligman TargETFunds, may include mortgage related securities).

 

  E11 – The fund will not invest more than 25% of the market value of its total assets in securities of issuers in any one industry, provided that the fund reserves the right to concentrate investments in money market instruments issued by the U.S. Government or its agencies or instrumentalities or banks or bank holding companies.

 

  E12 – The fund will not invest 25% or more of its total assets, at market value, in the securities of issuers in any particular industry, except that the fund will invest at least 25% of the value of its total assets in securities of issuers principally engaged in the real estate industry (in which the fund intends to concentrate) and may invest without limit in securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government or any of its agencies or instrumentalities.

 

  E13 – The fund will not invest 25% or more of its total assets, at market value, in the securities of issuers in any particular industry, except that the fund will invest at least 25% of the value of its total assets in securities of companies principally engaged in the communications, information and related industries and provided that this limitation shall exclude securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or any of its agencies or instrumentalities.

For purposes of applying the limitation set forth in the concentration policy, above, the funds will generally use the industry classifications provided by the Global Industry Classification System.

 

9


Table of Contents

 

F. Invest less than 80%

 

  F1 – The fund will not under normal market conditions, invest less than 80% of its net assets in municipal obligations that are generally exempt from federal income tax as well as respective state and local income tax.

 

  F2 – The fund will not under normal market conditions, invest less than 80% of its net assets in bonds and notes issued by or on behalf of state and local governmental units whose interest, in the opinion of counsel for the issuer, is exempt from federal income tax and is not subject to the alternative minimum tax.

 

  F3 – The fund will not under normal market conditions, invest less than 80% of its net assets in bonds and other debt securities issued by or on behalf of state or local governmental units whose interest, in the opinion of counsel for the issuer, is exempt from federal income tax.

 

  F4 – The fund will not, under normal market conditions, invest less than 80% of its net assets in securities the interest on which is exempt from regular federal income tax and (except for Seligman National Municipal) regular, personal income tax of its designated state, and temporary investments in taxable securities will be limited to 20% of the value of the fund’s net assets.

G. Act as an underwriter

 

  G1 – The fund will not act as an underwriter (sell securities for others). However, under the securities laws, the fund may be deemed to be an underwriter when it purchases securities directly from the issuer and later resells them.

 

  G2 – The fund will not underwrite the securities of other issuers, except insofar as the fund may be deemed an underwriter under the Securities Act of 1933 (the 1933 Act) in disposing of a portfolio security or in connection with investments in other investment companies.

 

  G3 – The fund will not underwrite the securities of other issuers; make “short” sales of securities, or purchase securities on “margin”; write or purchase put or call options.

H. Lending

 

  H1 –

The fund will not lend securities or participate in an interfund lending program if the total of all such loans would exceed 33 1/3% of the fund’s total assets except this fundamental investment policy shall not prohibit the fund from purchasing money market securities, loans, loan participation or other debt securities, or from entering into repurchase agreements. For funds-of-funds – equity, under current Board policy, the fund has no current intention to borrow to a material extent.

 

  H2 – The fund will not make loans, except to the extent that the purchase of notes, bonds or other evidences of indebtedness or deposits with banks may be considered loans.

 

  H3 – The fund will not make loans except to the extent that the purchase of notes, bonds or other evidences of indebtedness or the entry into repurchase agreements or deposits with banks may be considered loans. The fund does not have a present intention of entering into repurchase agreements.

 

  H4 – The fund will not make loans, except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

 

  H5 – The fund will not make loans, except loans of portfolio securities and except to the extent that the purchase of notes, bonds or other evidences of indebtedness, the entry into repurchase agreements or deposits with banks, may be considered loans.

I. Borrowing

 

  I1 –

The fund will not borrow money, except for temporary purposes (not for leveraging or investment) in an amount not exceeding 33 1/3% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings) immediately after the borrowings. For funds-of-funds – equity, under current Board policy, the fund has no current intention to borrow to a material extent.

 

  I2 – The fund will not borrow money, except from banks for temporary purposes (such as meeting redemption requests or for extraordinary or emergency purposes) in an amount not to exceed 10% of the value of its total assets at the time the borrowing is made (not including the amount borrowed). The fund will not purchase additional portfolio securities if the fund has outstanding borrowings in excess of 5% of the value of its total assets.

J. Issue senior securities

 

  J1 – The fund will not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable exemptive relief.

 

10


Table of Contents

 

  J2 – The fund will not issue senior securities or borrow money, except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

 

  J3 – The fund will not issue senior securities or borrow money, except from banks for temporary purposes in an amount not exceeding 5% of the value of its total assets.

K. Buy on margin/sell short

 

  K1 – The fund will not buy on margin or sell short or deal in options to buy or sell securities.

 

  K2 – The fund will not write or purchase put, call, straddle or spread options; purchase securities on margin or sell “short”; or underwrite the securities of other issuers.

 

  K3 – The fund will not purchase securities on margin except as permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule thereunder, any SEC or SEC staff interpretations thereof or any exemptions therefrom which may be granted by the SEC.

In addition to the policies described above and any fundamental policy described in the prospectus:

For Columbia Money Market, the fund will not:

 

   

Purchase common stocks, preferred stocks, warrants, other equity securities, corporate bonds or debentures, state bonds, municipal bonds, or industrial revenue bonds.

For Columbia Government Money Market, the fund will not:

 

   

Mortgage or pledge any of its assets, except to the extent, up to a maximum of 5% of its total assets, necessary to secure permissible borrowings.

 

   

Buy securities of any company which, with their predecessors, have been in operation less than three continuous years, provided however, that securities guaranteed by a company that (including predecessors) has been in operation at least three continuous years shall be excluded.

 

   

Invest in securities with contractual or other restrictions on resale, except in connection with repurchase agreements.

 

   

Deal with its directors and officers, or firms they are associated with, in the purchase or sale of securities except as broker, or purchase or hold the securities of any issuer, if to its knowledge, directors or officers of the fund or of the fund’s investment manager individually owning beneficially more than 0.5% of the securities of that other company own in the aggregate more than 5% of such securities.

 

   

Invest in the securities of companies for purposes of exercising control or management of such companies or in securities issued by other investment companies, except in connection with a merger, consolidation, acquisition or reorganization or for the purpose of hedging the fund’s obligations under its deferred compensation plan for directors.

For RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate and RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate, the fund will not:

 

   

Purchase or hold the securities of any issuer, if to its knowledge, directors or officers of the fund and, only in the case of Seligman Global Technology, the directors and officers of the fund’s investment manager or subadviser, individually owning beneficially more than 0.5% of the outstanding securities of that issuer own in the aggregate more than 5% of such securities.

For Seligman California Municipal High Yield, Seligman California Municipal Quality, Seligman Minnesota Municipal, Seligman National Municipal and Seligman New York Municipal, the fund will not:

 

   

Invest in securities issued by other investment companies, except in connection with a merger, consolidation, acquisition or reorganization, or for the purpose of hedging a fund’s obligations under its deferred compensation plan for directors/trustees.

 

   

Purchase or hold the securities of any issuer, if to its knowledge, directors/trustees or officers of a fund individually owning beneficially more than 0.5% of the securities of that issuer own in the aggregate more than 5% of such securities.

 

   

Mortgage or pledge any of its assets, except to secure permitted borrowings noted above.

For Seligman Capital and Seligman Growth, the fund will not:

 

   

Deal with its directors or officers, or firms they are associated with, in the purchase or sale of securities of other issuers, except as broker.

 

11


Table of Contents

 

For Seligman Capital, Columbia Seligman Communications and Information, Columbia Frontier, Columbia Seligman Global Technology, Columbia Select Growth, Columbia Select Large-Cap Value and Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value, the fund will not:

 

   

Purchase or hold the securities of any issuer, if to its knowledge, directors or officers of the fund and, only in the case of Seligman Global Technology, the directors and officers of the fund’s investment manager, individually owning beneficially more than 0.5% of the outstanding securities of that issuer own in the aggregate more than 5% of such securities.

 

   

Enter into repurchase agreements of more than one week’s duration if more than 10% of the fund’s net assets would be so invested.

NONFUNDAMENTAL POLICIES

Nonfundamental policies are policies that can be changed by the Board without shareholder approval. The following nonfundamental policies are in addition to those described in the prospectus.

For funds other than money market funds:

 

   

No more than 15% of the fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.

For money market funds:

 

   

No more than 5% of the fund’s net assets will be held in securities and other instruments that are illiquid.

Additionally, regarding limiting investments in foreign securities:

For Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity, Columbia Diversified Bond, Columbia Diversified Equity Income, Columbia Dividend Opportunity, Columbia Equity Value, Columbia Floating Rate, Columbia High Yield Bond, Columbia Income Opportunities, Columbia Inflation Protected Securities, Columbia Large Core Quantitative, Columbia Large Growth Quantitative, Columbia Large Value Quantitative, Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity, Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity, Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value, Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure, Seligman Capital, Columbia Select Large-Cap Value, Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value, Columbia Seligman Communications and Information, Columbia Frontier, RiverSource Balanced, RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity, RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value, RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate, Columbia Limited Duration Credit, RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value, RiverSource Real Estate and Seligman Growth:

 

   

Up to 25% of the fund’s net assets may be invested in foreign investments.

For RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining:

 

   

Under normal market conditions, the fund intends to invest at least 50% of its total assets in foreign investments.

For RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government and Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage:

 

   

Up to 20% of the fund’s net assets may be invested in foreign investments.

For Columbia Strategic Allocation:

 

   

The fund may invest its total assets, up to 50%, in foreign investments.

 

12


Table of Contents

 

Investment Strategies and Types of Investments

This table shows many of the various investment strategies and investments the funds are allowed to engage in and purchase. It is intended to show the breadth of investments that the investment manager or subadviser (individually and collectively, the “investment manager”) may make on behalf of a fund. For a description of principal risks for an individual fund, please see the applicable prospectus for that fund. Notwithstanding a fund’s ability to utilize these strategies and investments, the investment manager is not obligated to use them at any particular time. For example, even though the investment manager is authorized to adopt temporary defensive positions and is authorized to attempt to hedge against certain types of risk, these practices are left to the investment manager’s sole discretion.

Fund-of-funds invest in a combination of underlying funds, although they may invest directly in stocks, bonds and other securities. These underlying funds have their own investment strategies and types of investments they are allowed to engage in and purchase. Fund-of-funds currently only invest in underlying funds, which may invest directly in securities and engage in investment strategies, indicated in the table below.

Investment strategies and types of investments: A black circle indicates that the investment strategy or type of investment generally is authorized for a category of funds. Exceptions are noted in the footnotes to the table. See Table 1 for fund categories.

Table 3. Investment Strategies and Types of Investments

 

Investment strategy

   Balanced    Equity    Funds-of-Funds –
Equity and
Fixed Income
   Taxable
Fixed
Income
   Taxable
Money
Market
   Tax-Exempt
Fixed
Income
   State
Tax-Exempt
Fixed Income

Agency and government securities

                    

Borrowing

                    

Cash/money market instruments

                    

Collateralized bond obligations

           A          —        

Commercial paper

                    

Common stock

                 B    —      —      —  

Convertible securities

                 C    —        

Corporate bonds

               D      

Debt obligations

                    

Depositary receipts

               —      —      —  

Derivative instruments (including options and futures)

               —        

Exchange-traded funds

               —        

Floating rate loans

      —            —      —      —  

Foreign currency transactions

               —         —  

Foreign securities

                    

Funding agreements

                    

High yield debt securities (junk bonds)

               —              J

Illiquid and restricted securities

                    

Indexed securities

               —        

Inflation protected securities

               —        

Initial Public Offerings (IPOs)

                    

Inverse floaters

      E          —        

Investment companies

                    

Lending of portfolio securities

                    

Loan participations

               —        

Mortgage- and asset-backed securities

           F               

Mortgage dollar rolls

      G          —        

 

13


Table of Contents

Investment strategy

   Balanced    Equity    Funds-of-Funds –
Equity and
Fixed Income
   Taxable
Fixed
Income
   Taxable
Money
Market
   Tax-Exempt
Fixed
Income
   State
Tax-Exempt
Fixed Income

Municipal obligations

                    

Pay-in-kind securities

               —        

Preferred stock

                 H    —           H    —  

Real estate investment trusts

               —        

Repurchase agreements

                    

Reverse repurchase agreements

                    

Short sales

   I    I       I    —      I    I

Sovereign debt

                    

Structured investments

               —        

Swap agreements

               —        

Variable- or floating-rate securities

                    

Warrants

               —         —  

When-issued securities and forward commitments

               —        

Zero-coupon and step-coupon securities

                    

 

A. The following funds are not authorized to invest in collateralized bond obligations: RiverSource Partners International Select Growth, Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value, RiverSource Partners International Small Cap, and Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value.
B. The following funds are not authorized to invest in common stock: RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government, Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage.
C. The following funds are not authorized to invest in convertible securities: RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government, Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage.
D. While the fund is prohibited from investing in corporate bonds, it may invest in securities classified as corporate bonds if they meet the requirements of Rule 2a-7 of the 1940 Act.
E. The following fund is authorized to invest in inverse floaters: RiverSource Real Estate.
F. The following funds are not authorized to invest in mortgage- and asset-backed securities: RiverSource S&P 500 Index and RiverSource Small Company Index.
G. The following funds are authorized to invest in mortgage dollar rolls: RiverSource Real Estate.
H. The following funds are not authorized to invest in preferred stock: RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income, RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt, Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond, RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government, Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage.
I. Except for Seligman California Municipal High-Yield, Seligman California Municipal Quality, Seligman Minnesota Municipal and Seligman New York Municipal, which are prohibited from selling short, the funds are not prohibited from engaging in short sales, however, each fund will seek Board approval prior to utilizing short sales as an active part of its investment strategy.
J. The following funds are not authorized to invest in high yield debt securities: Seligman California Municipal Quality, Seligman Minnesota, Seligman National and Seligman New York.

 

14


Table of Contents

 

Information Regarding Risks and Investment Strategies

RISKS

The following is a summary of risk characteristics. Following this summary is a description of certain investments and investment strategies and the risks most commonly associated with them (including certain risks not described below and, in some cases, a more comprehensive discussion of how the risks apply to a particular investment or investment strategy). A mutual fund’s risk profile is largely defined by the fund’s primary portfolio holdings and investment strategies. However, most mutual funds are allowed to use certain other strategies and investments that may have different risk characteristics. Accordingly, one or more of the following types of risk may be associated with a fund at any time (for a description of principal risks and investment strategies for an individual fund, please see that fund’s prospectus):

Active Management Risk. For a fund that is actively managed, its performance will reflect in part the ability of the portfolio managers to select securities and to make investment decisions that are suited to achieving the fund’s investment objectives. Due to its active management, a fund could underperform other mutual funds with similar investment objectives and strategies.

Affiliated Fund Risk. For funds-of-funds, the risk that the investment manager may have potential conflicts of interest in selecting underlying funds because the fees paid to it by some underlying funds are higher than the fees paid by other underlying funds. However, the investment manager is a fiduciary to the funds and is legally obligated to act in their best interests when selecting underlying funds.

Allocation Risk. For funds-of-funds, the risk that the investment manager’s evaluations regarding asset classes or underlying funds may be incorrect. There is no guarantee that the underlying funds will achieve their investment objectives. There is also a risk that the selected underlying funds’ performance may be lower than the performance of the asset class they were selected to represent or may be lower than the performance of alternative underlying funds that could have been selected to represent the asset class.

Asian Pacific Region Risk. Many of the countries in the Asian Pacific Region are developing both politically and economically, and may have relatively unstable governments and economies based on a limited number of commodities or industries. Securities markets in the Asian Pacific Region are smaller and have a lower trading volume than those in the United States, which may result in the securities of some companies in the Asian Pacific Region being less liquid than similar U.S. or other foreign securities. Some currencies in the Asian Pacific Region are more volatile than the U.S. dollar, and some countries in the Asian Pacific Region have restricted the flow of money in and out of the country. As a result, many of the risks detailed above under “Risks of Foreign Investing” may be more pronounced due to concentration of the Fund’s investments in the Asian Pacific Region.

Borrowing Risk. To the extent the fund borrows money for investment purposes, which is commonly referred to as “leveraging,” the fund’s exposure to fluctuations in the prices of its assets will be increased as compared to the fund’s exposure if the fund did not borrow. The fund’s borrowing activities will exaggerate any increase or decrease in the net asset value of the fund. In addition, the interest which the fund pays on borrowed money, together with any additional costs of maintaining a borrowing facility, are additional costs borne by the fund and could reduce or eliminate any net investment profits. Unless profits on assets acquired with borrowed funds exceed the costs of borrowing, the use of borrowing will diminish the investment performance of the fund compared with what it would have been without borrowing. When the fund borrows money it must comply with certain asset coverage requirements, which at times may require the fund to dispose of some of its holdings, even though it may be disadvantageous to do so at the time.

Common Stock Risk. An adverse event, such as an unfavorable earnings report, may depress the value of a particular common stock held by the fund. Also, the prices of common stocks are sensitive to general movements in the stock market and a drop in the stock market may depress the price of common stocks to which the fund has exposure. Common stock prices fluctuate for several reasons, including changes to investors’ perceptions of the financial condition of an issuer or the general condition of the relevant stock market, or when political or economic events affecting an issuer occurs. In addition, common stock prices may be particularly sensitive to rising interest rates, as the cost of capital rises and borrowing costs increase.

Concentration Risk. Investments that are concentrated in a particular issuer, geographic region, or sector will make the fund’s portfolio value more susceptible to the events or conditions impacting the issuer, geographic region, or sector. Because of the fund’s concentration, the fund’s overall value may decline to a greater degree than if the fund held a less concentrated portfolio.

 

15


Table of Contents

 

Confidential Information Access Risk. For funds investing in floating rate loans, the investment manager normally will seek to avoid the receipt of material, non-public information (Confidential Information) about the issuers of floating rate loans being considered for acquisition by the fund, or held in the fund. In many instances, issuers of floating rate loans offer to furnish Confidential Information to prospective purchasers or holders of the issuer’s floating rate loans to help potential investors assess the value of the loan. The investment manager’s decision not to receive Confidential Information from these issuers may disadvantage the fund as compared to other floating rate loan investors, and may adversely affect the price the fund pays for the loans it purchases, or the price at which the fund sells the loans. Further, in situations when holders of floating rate loans are asked, for example, to grant consents, waivers or amendments, the investment manager’s ability to assess the desirability of such consents, waivers or amendments may be compromised. For these and other reasons, it is possible that the investment manager’s decision under normal circumstances not to receive Confidential Information could adversely affect the fund’s performance.

Counterparty Risk. Counterparty risk is the risk that a counterparty to a financial instrument entered into by the fund or held by a special purpose or structured vehicle becomes bankrupt or otherwise fails to perform its obligations due to financial difficulties. The fund may experience significant delays in obtaining any recovery in a bankruptcy or other reorganization proceeding. The fund may obtain only limited recovery or may obtain no recovery in such circumstances. The fund will typically enter into financial instrument transactions with counterparties whose credit rating is investment grade, or, if unrated, determined to be of comparable quality by the investment manager.

Credit Risk. Credit risk is the risk that one or more fixed income securities in the fund’s portfolio will decline in price or fail to pay interest or repay principal when due because the issuer of the security experiences a decline in its financial status and is unable or unwilling to honor its obligations, including the payment of interest or the repayment of principal. Adverse conditions in the credit markets can adversely affect the broader global economy, including the credit quality of issuers of fixed income securities in which the fund may invest. Changes by nationally recognized statistical rating organizations in its rating of securities and in the ability of an issuer to make scheduled payments may also affect the value of the fund’s investments. To the extent the fund invests in below-investment grade securities, it will be exposed to a greater amount of credit risk than a fund which invests solely in investment grade securities. The prices of lower grade securities are more sensitive to negative developments, such as a decline in the issuer’s revenues or a general economic downturn, than are the prices of higher grade securities. Fixed income securities of below investment grade quality are predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal when due and therefore involve a greater risk of default. If the fund purchases unrated securities, or if the rating of a security is reduced after purchase, the fund will depend on the investment manager’s analysis of credit risk more heavily than usual.

Derivatives Risk. Derivatives are financial instruments that have a value which depends upon, or is derived from, the value of something else, such as one or more underlying securities, pools of securities, options, futures, indexes or currencies. Losses involving derivative instruments may be substantial, because a relatively small price movement in the underlying security(ies), instrument, currency or index may result in a substantial loss for the fund. In addition to the potential for increased losses, the use of derivative instruments may lead to increased volatility within a fund. Derivative instruments in which the fund invests will typically increase the fund’s exposure to its principal risks (as described in the fund’s prospectus) to which it is otherwise exposed, and may expose the fund to additional risks, including correlation risk, counterparty credit risk, hedging risk, leverage risk, and liquidity risk.

Correlation risk is related to hedging risk and is the risk that there may be an incomplete correlation between the hedge and the opposite position, which may result in increased or unanticipated losses.

Counterparty credit risk is the risk that a counterparty to the derivative instrument becomes bankrupt or otherwise fails to perform its obligations due to financial difficulties, and the fund may obtain no recovery of its investment or may only obtain a limited recovery, and any recovery may be delayed.

Hedging risk is the risk that derivative instruments used to hedge against an opposite position may offset losses, but they may also offset gains. There is no guarantee that a hedging strategy will eliminate the risk which the hedging strategy is intended to offset, which may lead to losses within a fund.

Leverage risk is the risk that losses from the derivative instrument may be greater than the amount invested in the derivative instrument. Certain derivatives have the potential for unlimited losses, regardless of the size of the initial investment.

Liquidity risk is the risk that the derivative instrument may be difficult or impossible to sell or terminate, which may cause the fund to be in a position to do something the investment manager would not otherwise choose, including accepting a lower price for the derivative instrument, selling other investments or foregoing another, more appealing investment opportunity. Derivative instruments, which are not traded on an exchange, including, but not limited to, forward contracts, swaps, and over-the-counter options may have liquidity risk.

 

16


Table of Contents

 

Certain derivatives have the potential for unlimited losses regardless of the size of the initial investment.

Exchange-Traded Fund (ETF) Risk. An ETF’s share price may not track its specified market index and may trade below its net asset value. ETFs generally use a “passive” investment strategy and will not attempt to take defensive positions in volatile or declining markets. An active secondary market in an ETF’s shares may not develop or be maintained and may be halted or interrupted due to actions by its listing exchange, unusual market conditions or other reasons. There can be no assurance an ETF’s shares will continue to be listed on an active exchange. In addition, shareholders bear both their proportionate share of the fund’s expenses and similar expenses incurred through ownership of the ETF.

The funds generally expect to purchase shares of ETFs through broker-dealers in transactions on a securities exchange, and in such cases the funds will pay customary brokerage commissions for each purchase and sale. Shares of an ETF may also be acquired by depositing a specified portfolio of the ETF’s underlying securities, as well as a cash payment generally equal to accumulated dividends of the securities (net of expenses) up to the time of deposit, with the ETF’s custodian, in exchange for which the ETF will issue a quantity of new shares sometimes referred to as a “creation unit”. Similarly, shares of an ETF purchased on an exchange may be accumulated until they represent a creation unit, and the creation unit may redeemed in kind for a portfolio of the underlying securities (based on the ETF’s net asset value) together with a cash payment generally equal to accumulated dividends as of the date of redemption. The funds may redeem creation units for the underlying securities (and any applicable cash), and may assemble a portfolio of the underlying securities (and any required cash) to purchase creation units. The funds’ ability to redeem creation units may be limited by the 1940 Act, which provides that ETFs will not be obligated to redeem shares held by the funds in an amount exceeding one percent of their total outstanding securities during any period of less than 30 days.

There is a risk that ETFs in which a fund invests may terminate due to extraordinary events. For example, any of the service providers to ETFs, such as the trustee or sponsor, may close or otherwise fail to perform their obligations to the ETF, and the ETF may not be able to find a substitute service provider. Also, ETFs may be dependent upon licenses to use the various indices as a basis for determining their compositions and/or otherwise to use certain trade names. If these licenses are terminated, the ETFs may also terminate. In addition, an ETF may terminate if its net assets fall below a certain amount.

Focused Portfolio Risk. The fund expects to invest in a limited number of companies. Accordingly, the fund may have more volatility and is considered to have more risk than a fund that invests in a greater number of companies because changes in the value of a single security may have a more significant effect, either negative or positive, on the fund’s net asset value. To the extent the Fund invests its assets in fewer securities, the fund is subject to greater risk of loss if any of those securities declines in price.

Foreign Currency Risk. The Fund’s exposure to foreign currencies subjects the Fund to constantly changing exchange rates and the risk that those currencies will decline in value relative to the U.S. dollar, or, in the case of short positions, that the U.S. dollar will decline in value relative to the currency being sold forward. Currency rates in foreign countries may fluctuate significantly over short periods of time for a number of reasons, including changes in interest rates and economic or political developments in the U.S. or abroad. As a result, the Fund’s exposure to foreign currencies may reduce the returns of the Fund. Trading of foreign currencies also includes the risk of clearing and settling trades which, if prices are volatile, may be difficult.

Foreign/Emerging Markets Risk. Foreign securities are securities of issuers based outside the United States. An issuer is deemed to be based outside the United States if it is organized under the laws of another country. Foreign securities are primarily denominated in foreign currencies. In addition to the risks normally associated with domestic securities of the same type, foreign securities are subject to the following risks:

Country risk includes the political, economic, and other conditions of the country. These conditions include lack of publicly available information, less government oversight and regulation of business and industry practices of stock exchanges, brokers and listed companies than in the U.S. (including lack of uniform accounting, auditing, and financial reporting standards comparable to those applicable to domestic companies). In addition, with certain foreign countries, there is the possibility of nationalization, expropriation, the imposition of additional withholding or confiscatory taxes, political, social, or economic instability, diplomatic developments that could affect investments in those countries, or other unforeseen actions by regulatory bodies (such as changes to settlement or custody procedures). It may be more difficult for an investor’s agents to keep currently informed about corporate actions such as stock dividends or other matters that may affect the prices of portfolio securities. The liquidity of foreign investments may be more limited than for most U.S. investments, which means that, at times it may be difficult to sell foreign securities at desirable prices. Payment for securities without delivery may be required in certain foreign markets and, when participating in new issues, some foreign countries require payment to be made in advance of issuance (at the time of issuance, the market value of the security may be more or less than the purchase price). Fixed commissions on some foreign stock exchanges are generally higher than negotiated commissions on U.S. exchanges. Further, the Fund may encounter difficulties or be unable to pursue legal remedies and obtain judgments in

 

17


Table of Contents

foreign courts. The introduction of a single currency, the euro, on Jan. 1, 1999 for participating European nations in the Economic and Monetary Union (EU) presents unique risks. The most important is the exposure to the economic, political and social development of the member countries in the EU.

Currency risk results from the constantly changing exchange rates between local currency and the U.S. dollar. Whenever the fund holds securities valued in a foreign currency or holds the currency, changes in the exchange rate add to or subtract from the value of the investment.

Custody risk refers to the process of clearing and settling trades. It also covers holding securities with local agents and depositories. Low trading volumes and volatile prices in less developed markets make trades harder to complete and settle. Local agents are held only to the standard of care of the local market. Governments or trade groups may compel local agents to hold securities in designated depositories that are not subject to independent evaluation. The less developed a country’s securities market is, the greater the likelihood of problems occurring.

Emerging markets risk includes the dramatic pace of change (economic, social, and political) in these countries as well as the other considerations listed above. These markets are in early stages of development and are extremely volatile. They can be marked by extreme inflation, devaluation of currencies, dependence on trade partners, and hostile relations with neighboring countries.

Geographic Concentration Risk. The fund may be particularly susceptible to economic, political or regulatory events affecting companies and countries within the specific geographic region in which the fund focuses its investments. Currency devaluations could occur in countries that have not yet experienced currency devaluation to date, or could continue to occur in countries that have already experienced such devaluations. As a result, the fund may be more volatile than a more geographically diversified fund.

For state-specific funds. Because state-specific tax-exempt funds invest primarily in the municipal securities issued by the state and political sub-divisions of the state, each fund will be particularly affected by political and economic changes, adverse conditions to an industry significant to the area and other developments in the state in which it invests. This vulnerability to factors affecting the state’s tax-exempt investments will be significantly greater than that of a more geographically diversified fund, which may result in greater losses and volatility. See Appendix B for details. The value of municipal securities owned by a fund also may be adversely affected by future changes in federal or state income tax laws.

In addition, because of the relatively small number of issuers of tax-exempt securities and because the state-specific funds may concentrate in a segment of the tax-exempt debt market, such as revenue bonds for health care facilities, housing or airports, the fund may invest a higher percentage of its assets in a single issuer and, therefore, be more exposed to the risk of loss by investing in a few issuers than a fund that invests more broadly. At times, the fund and other accounts managed by the investment manager may own all or most of the debt of a particular issuer. These investments may cause the value of a fund’s shares to change more than the values of other funds’ shares that invest in more diversified investments. This concentration of ownership may make it more difficult to sell, or to determine the fair value of, these investments. The yields on the securities in which the fund invests generally are dependent on a variety of factors, including the financial condition of the issuer or other obligor, the revenue source from which the debt service is payable, general economic and monetary conditions, conditions in the relevant market, the size of a particular issue, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. Because many tax-exempt bonds may be revenue or general obligations of local governments or authorities, ratings on tax-exempt bonds may be different from the ratings given to the general obligation bonds of a particular state.

More information about state specific risks may be available from official state resources.

Highly Leveraged Transactions Risk. Certain corporate loans and corporate debt securities involve refinancings, recapitalizations, mergers and acquisitions, and other financings for general corporate purposes. These investments also may include senior obligations of a borrower issued in connection with a restructuring pursuant to Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code (commonly known as “debtor-in-possession” financings), provided that such senior obligations are determined by the fund’s investment manager upon its credit analysis to be a suitable investment by the fund. In such highly leveraged transactions, the borrower assumes large amounts of debt in order to have the financial resources to attempt to achieve its business objectives. Such business objectives may include but are not limited to: management’s taking over control of a company (leveraged buy-out); reorganizing the assets and liabilities of a company (leveraged recapitalization); or acquiring another company. Loans or securities that are part of highly leveraged transactions involve a greater risk (including default and bankruptcy) than other investments.

Impairment of Collateral Risk. The value of collateral, if any, securing a floating rate loan can decline, and may be insufficient to meet the borrower’s obligations or difficult to liquidate. In addition, the fund’s access to collateral may be limited by bankruptcy or other insolvency laws. Further, certain floating rate loans may not be fully collateralized and may decline in value.

 

18


Table of Contents

 

Indexing Risk. For funds that are managed to an index, the fund’s performance will rise and fall, subject to any tracking error, as the performance of the index rises and falls.

Inflation-Protected Securities Risk. Inflation-protected debt securities tend to react to change in real interest rates. Real interest rates can be described as nominal interest rates minus the expected impact of inflation. In general, the price of an inflation-protected debt security falls when real interest rates rise, and rises when real interest rates fall. Interest payments on inflation-protected debt securities will vary as the principal and/or interest is adjusted for inflation and may be more volatile than interest paid on ordinary bonds. In periods of deflation, the fund may have no income at all. Income earned by a shareholder depends on the amount of principal invested and that principal cannot seek to grow with inflation unless the investor reinvests the portion of fund distributions that comes from inflation adjustments.

Infrastructure-Related Companies Risk. Investments in infrastructure-related securities have greater exposure to adverse economic, regulatory, political, legal, and other changes affecting the issuers of such securities. Infrastructure-related businesses are subject to a variety of factors that may adversely affect their business or operations including high interest costs in connection with capital construction programs, costs associated with environmental and other regulations, the effects of economic slowdown and surplus capacity, increased competition from other providers of services, uncertainties concerning availability of fuel at reasonable prices, the effects of energy conservation policies and other factors. Additionally, infrastructure-related entities may be subject to regulation by various governmental authorities and may also be affected by governmental regulation of rates charged to customers, service interruption and/or legal challenges due to environmental, operational or other mishaps and the imposition of special tariffs and changes in tax laws, regulatory policies and accounting standards. There is also the risk that corruption may negatively affect publicly-funded infrastructure projects, especially in foreign markets, resulting in delays and cost overruns.

Initial Public Offering (IPO) Risk. IPOs are subject to many of the same risks as investing in companies with smaller market capitalizations. To the extent a fund determines to invest in IPOs it may not be able to invest to the extent desired, because, for example, only a small portion (if any) of the securities being offered in an IPO may be made available. The investment performance of a fund during periods when it is unable to invest significantly or at all in IPOs may be lower than during periods when the fund is able to do so. In addition, as a fund increases in size, the impact of IPOs on the fund’s performance will generally decrease. IPOs sold within 12 months of purchase will result in increased short-term capital gains, which will be taxable to shareholders as ordinary income.

Interest Rate Risk. The securities in the portfolio are subject to the risk of losses attributable to changes in interest rates. Interest rate risk is generally associated with bond prices: when interest rates rise, bond prices generally fall. In general, the longer the maturity or duration of a bond, the greater its sensitivity to changes in interest rates. Interest rate changes also may increase prepayments of debt obligations, which in turn would increase prepayment risk.

Issuer Risk. An issuer, or the value of its securities, may perform poorly. Poor performance may be caused by poor management decisions, competitive pressures, breakthroughs in technology, reliance on suppliers, labor problems or shortages, corporate restructurings, fraudulent disclosures, or other factors.

Leverage Risk. Leverage occurs when the fund increases its assets available for investment using borrowings, short sales, derivatives, or similar instruments or techniques. Due to the fact that short sales involve borrowing securities and then selling them, the fund’s short sales effectively leverage the fund’s assets. The use of leverage may make any change in the fund’s net asset value (“NAV”) even greater and thus result in increased volatility of returns. The fund’s assets that are used as collateral to secure the short sales may decrease in value while the short positions are outstanding, which may force the fund to use its other assets to increase the collateral. Leverage can also create an interest expense that may lower the fund’s overall returns. Lastly, there is no guarantee that a leveraging strategy will be successful.

Liquidity Risk. The risk associated from a lack of marketability of securities which may make it difficult or impossible to sell at desirable prices in order to minimize loss. The Fund may have to lower the selling price, sell other investments, or forego another, more appealing investment opportunity.

Market Risk. The market value of securities may fall or fail to rise. Market risk may affect a single issuer, sector of the economy, industry, or the market as a whole. The market value of securities may fluctuate, sometimes rapidly and unpredictably. This risk is generally greater for small and mid-sized companies, which tend to be more vulnerable to adverse developments. In addition, focus on a particular style, for example, investment in growth or value securities, may cause the Fund to underperform other mutual funds if that style falls out of favor with the market.

Master Limited Partnership Risk. Investments in securities (units) of master limited partnerships involve risks that differ from an investment in common stock. Holders of the units of master limited partnerships have more limited control and limited rights to vote on matters affecting the partnership. There are also certain tax risks associated with an investment in units of master limited partnerships. In addition, conflicts of interest may exist between common unit holders, subordinated

 

19


Table of Contents

unit holders and the general partner of a master limited partnership, including a conflict arising as a result of incentive distribution payments.

Mortgage-Related and Other Asset-Backed Securities Risk. Generally, rising interest rates tend to extend the duration of fixed rate mortgage-related securities, making them more sensitive to changes in interest rates. As a result, in a period of rising interest rates, if a fund holds mortgage-related securities, it may exhibit additional volatility. This is known as extension risk. In addition, adjustable and fixed rate mortgage-related securities are subject to prepayment risk. When interest rates decline, borrowers may pay off their mortgages sooner.

Municipal Securities Risk. The value of a municipal security may be affected by legislative or administrative actions as well as by the economics of the region where the issuer of the municipal security is located. For example, a significant restructuring of federal income tax rates could cause municipal security prices to fall. Lower income tax rates could reduce the advantage of owning municipal securities.

Non-Diversification Risk. A non-diversified fund may invest more of its assets in fewer companies than if it were a diversified fund. Because each investment has a greater effect on the fund’s performance, the fund may be more exposed to the risks of loss and volatility than a fund that invests more broadly.

Portfolio Trading and Turnover Risks. Portfolio trading may be undertaken to accomplish the investment objectives of the funds in relation to actual and anticipated movements in interest rates, securities markets and for other reasons. In addition, a security may be sold and another of comparable quality purchased at approximately the same time to take advantage of what the investment manager believes to be a temporary price disparity between the two securities. Temporary price disparities between two comparable securities may result from supply and demand imbalances where, for example, a temporary oversupply of certain securities may cause a temporarily low price for such security, as compared with other securities of like quality and characteristics. A fund may also engage in short-term trading consistent with its investment objectives. Securities may be sold in anticipation of a market decline or purchased in anticipation of a market rise and later sold, or to recognize a gain.

A change in the securities held by a fund is known as “portfolio turnover.” The use of certain derivative instruments with relatively short maturities may tend to exaggerate the portfolio turnover rate for a fund. High portfolio turnover may involve correspondingly greater expenses to the fund, including brokerage commissions or dealer mark-ups and other transaction costs on the sale of securities and reinvestments in other securities. Trading in debt obligations does not generally involve the payment of brokerage commissions, but does involve indirect transaction costs. The use of futures contracts may involve the payment of commissions to futures commission merchants. The higher the rate of portfolio turnover of the fund, the higher the transaction costs borne by the fund generally will be. Transactions in the fund’s portfolio securities may result in realization of taxable capital gains (including short-term capital gains which are generally taxed to stockholders at ordinary income tax rates). The trading costs and tax effects associated with portfolio turnover may adversely affect the fund’s performance.

Prepayment and Extension Risk. The risk that a bond or other security might be called, or otherwise converted, prepaid, or redeemed, before maturity. This risk is primarily associated with asset-backed securities, including mortgage backed securities. If a security is converted, prepaid, or redeemed, before maturity, particularly during a time of declining interest rates, the portfolio managers may not be able to reinvest in securities providing as high a level of income, resulting in a reduced yield to the fund. Conversely, as interest rates rise, the likelihood of prepayment decreases. The portfolio managers may be unable to capitalize on securities with higher interest rates because the Fund’s investments are locked in at a lower rate for a longer period of time.

Quantitative Model Risk. Securities selected using quantitative methods may perform differently from the market as a whole as a result of the factors used in the quantitative method, the weight placed on each factor, and changes in the factors’ historical trends. The quantitative methodology employed by the investment manager has been extensively tested using historical securities market data, but has only recently begun to be used to manage the funds. There can be no assurance that the methodology will enable the fund to achieve its objective.

Real Estate Industry Risk. Certain underlying funds concentrate their investments in securities of companies operating in the real estate industry, making the fund is more susceptible to risks associated with the ownership of real estate and with the real estate industry in general. These risks can include fluctuations in the value of the underlying properties, defaults by borrowers or tenants, market saturation, decreases in market rates for rents, and other economic, political, or regulatory occurrences affecting the real estate industry, including REITs.

REITs depend upon specialized management skills, may have limited financial resources, may have less trading volume, and may be subject to more abrupt or erratic price movements than the overall securities markets. REITs are also subject to the risk of failing to qualify for tax-free pass-through of income. Some REITs (especially mortgage REITs) are affected by risks

 

20


Table of Contents

similar to those associated with investments in debt securities including changes in interest rates and the quality of credit extended.

Reinvestment Risk. The risk that an investor will not be able to reinvest income or principal at the same rate it currently is earning.

Retirement Goal Risk. For Retirement Plus Funds, the investor may have different needs than the quantitative model anticipates.

Sector Risk. Investments that are concentrated in a particular issuer, geographic region, or sector will be more susceptible to changes in price. The more a fund diversifies, the more it spreads risk and potentially reduces the risks of loss and volatility.

Short Selling Risk. The fund may make short sales, which involves selling a security the fund does not own in anticipation that the security’s price will decline. The fund must borrow those securities to make delivery to the buyer. The fund may not always be able to borrow a security it wants to sell short. The fund will suffer a loss if it sells a security short and the value of the security rises rather than falls. It is possible that the fund’s long positions will decline in value at the same time that the value of its short positions increase, thereby increasing potential losses to the fund. Short sales expose the fund to the risk that it will be required to buy the security sold short (also known as “covering” the short position) at a time when the security has appreciated in value, thus resulting in a loss to the fund. The fund may also be required to close out a short position at a time when it might not otherwise choose, for example, if the lender of the security calls it back, which may have the effect of reducing or eliminating potential gain, or cause the fund to realize a loss. Short positions introduce more risk to the fund than long positions (purchases) because the maximum sustainable loss on a security purchased (held long) is limited to the amount paid for the security plus the transaction costs, whereas there is no maximum attainable price of the shorted security. Therefore, in theory, securities sold short have unlimited risk. Additionally, the fund’s use of short sales in effect “leverages” the fund, as the fund intends to use the cash proceeds from short sales to invest in additional long positions. This leverage effect potentially exposes the fund to greater risks due to unanticipated market movements, which may magnify losses and increase the volatility of returns. See Leverage Risk and Market Risk.

Small and Mid-Sized Company Risk. Investments in small and medium companies often involve greater risks than investments in larger, more established companies because small and medium companies may lack the management experience, financial resources, product diversification, experience, and competitive strengths of larger companies. Additionally, in many instances the securities of small and medium companies are traded only over-the-counter or on regional securities exchanges and the frequency and volume of their trading is substantially less and may be more volatile than is typical of larger companies.

Tax Risk. As a regulated investment company, a fund must derive at least 90% of its gross income for each taxable year from sources treated as “qualifying income” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. The fund currently intends to take positions in forward currency contracts with notional value up to the fund’s total net assets. Although foreign currency gains currently constitute “qualifying income” the Treasury Department has the authority to issue regulations excluding from the definition of “qualifying incomes” a fund’s foreign currency gains not “directly related” to its “principal business” of investing in stocks or securities (or options and futures with respect thereto). Such regulations might treat gains from some of the fund’s foreign currency-denominated positions as not “qualifying income” and there is a remote possibility that such regulations might be applied retroactively, in which case, the fund might not qualify as a regulated investment company for one or more years. In the event the Treasury Department issues such regulations, the fund’s Board of Directors may authorize a significant change in investment strategy or fund liquidation.

Technology and Technology-Related Investment Risks. The market prices of technology and technology-related stocks tend to exhibit a greater degree of market risk and price volatility than other types of investments. These stocks may fall in and out of favor with investors rapidly, which may cause sudden selling and dramatically lower market prices. These stocks also may be affected adversely by changes in technology, consumer and business purchasing patterns, government regulation and/or obsolete products or services. In addition, a rising interest rate environment tends to negatively affect technology and technology-related companies. In such an environment, those companies with high market valuations may appear less attractive to investors, which may cause sharp decreases in the companies’ market prices. Further, those technology or technology-related companies seeking to finance their expansion would have increased borrowing costs, which may negatively impact their earnings. As a result, these factors may negatively affect the performance of the fund. Finally, the fund may be susceptible to factors affecting the technology and technology-related industries. Technology and technology-related companies are often smaller and less experienced companies and may be subject to greater risks than larger companies, such as limited product lines, markets and financial and managerial resources. These risks may be heightened for technology companies in foreign markets.

Tracking Error Risk. For funds that are managed to an index, the fund may not track the index perfectly because differences between the index and the fund’s portfolio can cause differences in performance. The investment manager

 

21


Table of Contents

purchases securities and other instruments in an attempt to replicate the performance of the index. However, the tools that the investment manager uses to replicate the index are not perfect and the fund’s performance is affected by factors such as the size of the fund’s portfolio, transaction costs, management fees and expenses, brokerage commissions and fees, the extent and timing of cash flows in and out of the fund and changes in the index.

In addition, the returns from a specific type of security (for example, mid-cap stocks) may trail returns from other asset classes or the overall market. Each type of security will go through cycles of doing better or worse than stocks or bonds in general. These periods may last for several years.

Underlying Fund Selection Risk. For funds-of-funds, the risk that the selected underlying funds’ performance may be lower than the performance of the asset class they were selected to represent or may be lower than the performance of alternative underlying funds that could have been selected to represent the investment category.

INVESTMENT STRATEGIES

The following information supplements the discussion of each fund’s investment objectives, policies, and strategies that are described in the prospectus and in this SAI. The following describes strategies that many mutual funds use and types of securities that they purchase. Please refer to the table titled Investment Strategies and Types of Investments to see which are applicable to various categories of funds.

Agency and Government Securities

The U.S. government, its agencies and instrumentalities, and government-sponsored enterprises issue many different types of securities. U.S. Treasury bonds, notes, and bills and securities, including mortgage pass through certificates of the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA), are guaranteed by the U.S. government.

Other U.S. government securities are issued or guaranteed by federal agencies or instrumentalities or government-sponsored enterprises but are not guaranteed by the U.S. government. This may increase the credit risk associated with these investments. Government-sponsored entities issuing securities include privately owned, publicly chartered entities created to reduce borrowing costs for certain sectors of the economy, such as farmers, homeowners, and students. They include the Federal Farm Credit Bank System, Farm Credit Financial Assistance Corporation, Federal Home Loan Bank, Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation* (FHLMC), Federal National Mortgage Association* (FNMA), Student Loan Marketing Association (SLMA), and Resolution Trust Corporation (RTC). Government-sponsored entities may issue discount notes (with maturities ranging from overnight to 360 days) and bonds. Agency and government securities are subject to the same concerns as other debt obligations. (See also Debt Obligations and Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Securities.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with agency and government securities include: Inflation Risk, Interest Rate Risk, Prepayment and Extension Risk, and Reinvestment Risk.

 

* On Sept. 7, 2008, the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), an agency of the U.S. government, placed the FHLMC and FNMA into conservatorship, a statutory process with the objective of returning the entities to normal business operations. FHFA will act as the conservator to operate the enterprises until they are stabilized.

Borrowing

If the fund borrows money, its share price may be subject to greater fluctuation until the borrowing is paid off. If the fund makes additional investments while borrowings are outstanding, this may be considered a form of leverage. Under the 1940 Act, the fund is required to maintain continuous asset coverage of 300% with respect to such borrowings and to sell (within three days) sufficient portfolio holdings to restore such coverage if it should decline to less than 300% due to market fluctuations or otherwise, even if such liquidations of the fund’s holdings may be disadvantageous from an investment standpoint. Leveraging by means of borrowing may exaggerate the effect of any increase or decrease in the value of portfolio securities or the fund’s NAV, and money borrowed will be subject to interest and other costs (which may include commitment fees and/or the cost of maintaining minimum average balances) which may or may not exceed the income received from the securities purchased with borrowed funds.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with borrowing include: Inflation Risk.

Cash/Money Market Instruments

Cash-equivalent investments include short-term U.S. and Canadian government securities and negotiable certificates of deposit, non-negotiable fixed-time deposits, bankers’ acceptances, and letters of credit of banks or savings and loan associations having capital, surplus, and undivided profits (as of the date of its most recently published annual financial statements) in excess of $100 million (or the equivalent in the instance of a foreign branch of a U.S. bank) at the date of investment. A fund also may purchase short-term notes and obligations of U.S. and foreign banks and corporations and may

 

22


Table of Contents

use repurchase agreements with broker-dealers registered under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and with commercial banks. (See also Commercial Paper, Debt Obligations, Repurchase Agreements, and Variable- or Floating-Rate Securities.) These types of instruments generally offer low rates of return and subject a fund to certain costs and expenses. See Appendix A for a discussion of securities ratings.

Bankers’ acceptances are marketable short-term credit instruments used to finance the import, export, transfer or storage of goods. They are termed “accepted” when a bank guarantees their payment at maturity.

Bank certificates of deposit are certificates issued against funds deposited in a bank (including eligible foreign branches of U.S. banks), are for a definite period of time, earn a specified rate of return and are normally negotiable.

A fund may invest its daily cash balance in RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund, a money market fund established for the exclusive use of the RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds and other institutional clients of Columbia Management.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with cash/money market instruments include: Credit Risk and Inflation Risk.

Collateralized Bond Obligations

Collateralized bond obligations (CBOs) are investment grade bonds backed by a pool of bonds, which may include junk bonds. CBOs are similar in concept to collateralized mortgage obligations (CMOs), but differ in that CBOs represent different degrees of credit quality rather than different maturities. (See also Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Securities.) Underwriters of CBOs package a large and diversified pool of high-risk, high-yield junk bonds, which is then separated into “tiers.” Typically, the first tier represents the higher quality collateral and pays the lowest interest rate; the second tier is backed by riskier bonds and pays a higher rate; the third tier represents the lowest credit quality and instead of receiving a fixed interest rate receives the residual interest payments — money that is left over after the higher tiers have been paid. CBOs, like CMOs, are substantially overcollateralized and this, plus the diversification of the pool backing them, may earn certain of the tiers investment-grade bond ratings. Holders of third-tier CBOs stand to earn high yields or less money depending on the rate of defaults in the collateral pool. (See also High-Yield Debt Securities (Junk Bonds).)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with CBOs include: Credit Risk, Interest Rate Risk and Prepayment and Extension Risk.

Commercial Paper

Commercial paper is a short-term debt obligation with a maturity ranging from 2 to 270 days issued by banks, corporations, and other borrowers. It is sold to investors with temporary idle cash as a way to increase returns on a short-term basis. These instruments are generally unsecured, which increases the credit risk associated with this type of investment. (See also Debt Obligations and Illiquid and Restricted Securities.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with commercial paper include: Credit Risk and Liquidity Risk.

Common Stock

Common stock represents units of ownership in a corporation. Owners typically are entitled to vote on the selection of directors and other important matters as well as to receive dividends on their holdings. In the event that a corporation is liquidated, the claims of secured and unsecured creditors and owners of bonds and preferred stock take precedence over the claims of those who own common stock.

The price of common stock is generally determined by corporate earnings, type of products or services offered, projected growth rates, experience of management, liquidity, and general market conditions for the markets on which the stock trades.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with common stock include: Issuer Risk, Market Risk, and Small and Mid-Sized Company Risk.

Convertible Securities

Convertible securities are bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks, or other securities that may be converted into common, preferred or other securities of the same or a different issuer within a particular period of time at a specified price. Some convertible securities, such as preferred equity-redemption cumulative stock (PERCs), have mandatory conversion features. Others are voluntary. A convertible security entitles the holder to receive interest normally paid or accrued on debt or the dividend paid on preferred stock until the convertible security matures or is redeemed, converted, or exchanged. Convertible securities have unique investment characteristics in that they generally (i) have higher yields than common stocks but lower yields than comparable non-convertible securities, (ii) are less subject to fluctuation in value than the underlying stock since

 

23


Table of Contents

they have fixed income characteristics, and (iii) provide the potential for capital appreciation if the market price of the underlying common stock increases.

The value of a convertible security is a function of its “investment value” (determined by its yield in comparison with the yields of other securities of comparable maturity and quality that do not have a conversion privilege) and its “conversion value” (the security’s worth, at market value, if converted into the underlying common stock). The investment value of a convertible security is influenced by changes in interest rates, with investment value declining as interest rates increase and increasing as interest rates decline. The credit standing of the issuer and other factors also may have an effect on the convertible security’s investment value. The conversion value of a convertible security is determined by the market price of the underlying common stock. If the conversion value is low relative to the investment value, the price of the convertible security is governed principally by its investment value. Generally, the conversion value decreases as the convertible security approaches maturity. To the extent the market price of the underlying common stock approaches or exceeds the conversion price, the price of the convertible security will be increasingly influenced by its conversion value. A convertible security generally will sell at a premium over its conversion value by the extent to which investors place value on the right to acquire the underlying common stock while holding a fixed income security.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with convertible securities include: Interest Rate Risk, Issuer Risk, Market Risk, Prepayment and Extension Risk, and Reinvestment Risk.

Corporate Bonds

Corporate bonds are debt obligations issued by private corporations, as distinct from bonds issued by a government or its agencies or a municipality. Corporate bonds typically have four distinguishing features: (1) they are taxable; (2) they have a par value of $1,000; (3) they have a term maturity, which means they come due all at once; and (4) many are traded on major exchanges. Corporate bonds are subject to the same concerns as other debt obligations. (See also Debt Obligations and High-Yield Debt Securities (Junk Bonds).) Corporate bonds may be either secured or unsecured. Unsecured corporate bonds are generally referred to as “debentures.” See Appendix A for a discussion of securities ratings.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with corporate bonds include: Credit Risk, Interest Rate Risk, Issuer Risk, Prepayment and Extension Risk, and Reinvestment Risk.

Debt Obligations

Many different types of debt obligations exist (for example, bills, bonds, or notes). Issuers of debt obligations have a contractual obligation to pay interest at a fixed, variable or floating rate on specified dates and to repay principal on a specified maturity date. Certain debt obligations (usually intermediate- and long-term bonds) have provisions that allow the issuer to redeem or “call” a bond before its maturity. Issuers are most likely to call these securities during periods of falling interest rates. When this happens, an investor may have to replace these securities with lower yielding securities, which could result in a lower return.

The market value of debt obligations is affected primarily by changes in prevailing interest rates and the issuers perceived ability to repay the debt. The market value of a debt obligation generally reacts inversely to interest rate changes. When prevailing interest rates decline, the price usually rises, and when prevailing interest rates rise, the price usually declines.

In general, the longer the maturity of a debt obligation, the higher its yield and the greater the sensitivity to changes in interest rates. Conversely, the shorter the maturity, the lower the yield but the greater the price stability.

As noted, the values of debt obligations also may be affected by changes in the credit rating or financial condition of their issuers. Generally, the lower the quality rating of a security, the higher the degree of risk as to the payment of interest and return of principal. To compensate investors for taking on such increased risk, those issuers deemed to be less creditworthy generally must offer their investors higher interest rates than do issuers with better credit ratings. (See also Agency and Government Securities, Corporate Bonds, and High-Yield Debt Securities (Junk Bonds).)

Generally, debt obligations that are investment grade are those that have been rated in one of the top four credit quality categories by two out of the three independent rating agencies. In the event that a debt obligation has been rated by only two agencies, the most conservative, or lower, rating must be in one of the top four credit quality categories in order for the security to be considered investment grade. If only one agency has rated the debt obligation, that rating must be in one of the top four credit quality categories for the security to be considered investment grade. See Appendix A for a discussion of securities ratings.

All ratings limitations are applied at the time of purchase. Subsequent to purchase, a debt security may cease to be rated or its rating may be reduced below the minimum required for purchase by a fund. Neither event will require the sale of such a security, but it will be a factor in considering whether to continue to hold the security. To the extent that ratings change as a

 

24


Table of Contents

result of changes in a rating agency or its rating system, a fund will attempt to use comparable ratings as standards for selecting investments.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with debt obligations include: Credit Risk, Interest Rate Risk, Issuer Risk, Prepayment and Extension Risk, and Reinvestment Risk.

Depositary Receipts

Some foreign securities are traded in the form of American Depositary Receipts (ADRs). ADRs are receipts typically issued by a U.S. bank or trust company evidencing ownership of the underlying securities of foreign issuers. European Depositary Receipts (EDRs) and Global Depositary Receipts (GDRs) are receipts typically issued by foreign banks or trust companies, evidencing ownership of underlying securities issued by either a foreign or U.S. issuer. Generally, depositary receipts in registered form are designed for use in the U.S. and depositary receipts in bearer form are designed for use in securities markets outside the U.S. Depositary receipts may not necessarily be denominated in the same currency as the underlying securities into which they may be converted. Depositary receipts involve the risks of other investments in foreign securities. In addition, ADR holders may not have all the legal rights of shareholders and may experience difficulty in receiving shareholder communications. (See also Common Stock and Foreign Securities.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with depositary receipts include: Foreign/Emerging Markets Risk, Issuer Risk, and Market Risk.

Derivative Instruments

Derivative instruments are commonly defined to include securities or contracts whose values depend, in whole or in part, on (or “derive” from) the value of one or more other assets, such as securities, currencies, or commodities.

A derivative instrument generally consists of, is based upon, or exhibits characteristics similar to options or forward contracts. Such instruments may be used to maintain cash reserves while remaining fully invested, to offset anticipated declines in values of investments, to facilitate trading, to reduce transaction costs, or to pursue higher investment returns. Derivative instruments are characterized by requiring little or no initial payment. Their value changes daily based on a security, a currency, a group of securities or currencies, or an index. A small change in the value of the underlying security, currency, or index can cause a sizable percentage gain or loss in the price of the derivative instrument.

Options and forward contracts are considered to be the basic “building blocks” of derivatives. For example, forward- based derivatives include forward contracts, swap contracts, and exchange-traded futures. Forward-based derivatives are sometimes referred to generically as “futures contracts.” Option-based derivatives include privately negotiated, over-the-counter (OTC) options (including caps, floors, collars, and options on futures) and exchange-traded options on futures. Diverse types of derivatives may be created by combining options or futures in different ways, and by applying these structures to a wide range of underlying assets.

Options. An option is a contract. A person who buys a call option for a security has the right to buy the security at a set price for the length of the contract. A person who sells a call option is called a writer. The writer of a call option agrees for the length of the contract to sell the security at the set price when the buyer wants to exercise the option, no matter what the market price of the security is at that time. A person who buys a put option has the right to sell a security at a set price for the length of the contract. A person who writes a put option agrees to buy the security at the set price if the purchaser wants to exercise the option during the length of the contract, no matter what the market price of the security is at that time. An option is covered if the writer owns the security (in the case of a call) or sets aside the cash or securities of equivalent value (in the case of a put) that would be required upon exercise.

The price paid by the buyer for an option is called a premium. In addition to the premium, the buyer generally pays a broker a commission. The writer receives a premium, less another commission, at the time the option is written. The premium received by the writer is retained whether or not the option is exercised. A writer of a call option may have to sell the security for a below-market price if the market price rises above the exercise price. A writer of a put option may have to pay an above-market price for the security if its market price decreases below the exercise price.

When an option is purchased, the buyer pays a premium and a commission. It then pays a second commission on the purchase or sale of the underlying security if the option is exercised. For record keeping and tax purposes, the price obtained on the sale of the underlying security is the combination of the exercise price, the premium, and both commissions.

One of the risks an investor assumes when it buys an option is the loss of the premium. To be beneficial to the investor, the price of the underlying security must change within the time set by the option contract. Furthermore, the change must be sufficient to cover the premium paid, the commissions paid both in the acquisition of the option and in a closing transaction or in the exercise of the option and sale (in the case of a call) or purchase (in the case of a put) of the underlying security.

 

25


Table of Contents

Even then, the price change in the underlying security does not ensure a profit since prices in the option market may not reflect such a change.

Options on many securities are listed on options exchanges. If a fund writes listed options, it will follow the rules of the options exchange. Options are valued at the close of the New York Stock Exchange. An option listed on a national exchange, Chicago Board Options Exchange, or NASDAQ will be valued at the mean of the last bid and ask prices.

Options on certain securities are not actively traded on any exchange, but may be entered into directly with a dealer. These options may be more difficult to close. If an investor is unable to effect a closing purchase transaction, it will not be able to sell the underlying security until the call written by the investor expires or is exercised.

Futures Contracts. A futures contract is a sales contract between a buyer (holding the “long” position) and a seller (holding the “short” position) for an asset with delivery deferred until a future date. The buyer agrees to pay a fixed price at the agreed future date and the seller agrees to deliver the asset. The seller hopes that the market price on the delivery date is less than the agreed upon price, while the buyer hopes for the contrary. Many futures contracts trade in a manner similar to the way a stock trades on a stock exchange and the commodity exchanges.

Generally, a futures contract is terminated by entering into an offsetting transaction. An offsetting transaction is effected by an investor taking an opposite position. At the time a futures contract is made, a good faith deposit called initial margin is set up. Daily thereafter, the futures contract is valued and the payment of variation margin is required so that each day a buyer would pay out cash in an amount equal to any decline in the contract’s value or receive cash equal to any increase. At the time a futures contract is closed out, a nominal commission is paid, which is generally lower than the commission on a comparable transaction in the cash market.

Futures contracts may be based on various securities, securities indexes (such as the S&P 500 Index), foreign currencies and other financial instruments and indexes.

A fund may engage in futures and related options transactions to produce incremental earnings, to hedge existing positions, and to increase flexibility. The fund intends to comply with Rule 4.5 of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), under which a mutual fund is exempt from the definition of a “commodity pool operator.” The fund, therefore, is not subject to registration or regulation as a commodity pool operator, meaning that the fund may invest in futures contracts without registering with the CFTC.

Options on Futures Contracts. Options on futures contracts give the holder a right to buy or sell futures contracts in the future. Unlike a futures contract, which requires the parties to the contract to buy and sell a security on a set date (some futures are settled in cash), an option on a futures contract merely entitles its holder to decide on or before a future date (within nine months of the date of issue) whether to enter into a contract. If the holder decides not to enter into the contract, all that is lost is the amount (premium) paid for the option. Further, because the value of the option is fixed at the point of sale, there are no daily payments of cash to reflect the change in the value of the underlying contract. However, since an option gives the buyer the right to enter into a contract at a set price for a fixed period of time, its value does change daily.

One of the risks in buying an option on a futures contract is the loss of the premium paid for the option. The risk involved in writing options on futures contracts an investor owns, or on securities held in its portfolio, is that there could be an increase in the market value of these contracts or securities. If that occurred, the option would be exercised and the asset sold at a lower price than the cash market price. To some extent, the risk of not realizing a gain could be reduced by entering into a closing transaction. An investor could enter into a closing transaction by purchasing an option with the same terms as the one previously sold. The cost to close the option and terminate the investor’s obligation, however, might still result in a loss. Further, the investor might not be able to close the option because of insufficient activity in the options market. Purchasing options also limits the use of monies that might otherwise be available for long-term investments.

Options on Indexes. Options on indexes are securities traded on national securities exchanges. An option on an index is similar to an option on a futures contract except all settlements are in cash. A fund exercising a put, for example, would receive the difference between the exercise price and the current index level. Options may also be traded with respect to other types of indexes, such as options on indexes of commodities futures.

Currency Options. Options on currencies are contracts that give the buyer the right, but not the obligation, to buy (call options) or sell (put options) a specified amount of a currency at a predetermined price (strike price) on or before the option matures (expiry date). Conversely, the seller has the obligation to buy or sell a currency option upon exercise of the option by the purchaser. Currency options are traded either on a national securities exchange or over-the-counter.

Tax and Accounting Treatment. As permitted under federal income tax laws and to the extent a fund is allowed to invest in futures contracts, a fund would intend to identify futures contracts as part of a mixed straddle and not mark them to market, that is, not treat them as having been sold at the end of the year at market value. If a fund is using short futures contracts for

 

26


Table of Contents

hedging purposes, the fund may be required to defer recognizing losses incurred on short futures contracts and on underlying securities. Any losses incurred on securities that are part of a straddle may be deferred to the extent there is unrealized appreciation on the offsetting position until the offsetting position is sold. Federal income tax treatment of gains or losses from transactions in options, options on futures contracts and indexes will depend on whether the option is a section 1256 contract. If the option is a non-equity option, a fund would either make a 1256(d) election and treat the option as a mixed straddle or mark to market the option at fiscal year end and treat the gain/loss as 40% short-term and 60% long-term.

The Internal Revenue Service (IRS) has ruled publicly that an exchange-traded call option is a security for purposes of the 50%-of-assets test and that its issuer is the issuer of the underlying security, not the writer of the option, for purposes of the diversification requirements.

Accounting for futures contracts will be according to generally accepted accounting principles. Initial margin deposits will be recognized as assets due from a broker (a fund’s agent in acquiring the futures position). During the period the futures contract is open, changes in value of the contract will be recognized as unrealized gains or losses by marking to market on a daily basis to reflect the market value of the contract at the end of each day’s trading. Variation margin payments will be made or received depending upon whether gains or losses are incurred. All contracts and options will be valued at the last-quoted sales price on their primary exchange.

Other Risks of Derivatives. The primary risk of derivatives is the same as the risk of the underlying asset, namely that the value of the underlying asset may go up or down. Adverse movements in the value of an underlying asset can expose an investor to losses. Derivative instruments may include elements of leverage and, accordingly, the fluctuation of the value of the derivative instrument in relation to the underlying asset may be magnified. The successful use of derivative instruments depends upon a variety of factors, particularly the investment manager’s ability to predict movements of the securities, currencies, and commodity markets, which requires different skills than predicting changes in the prices of individual securities. There can be no assurance that any particular strategy will succeed.

Another risk is the risk that a loss may be sustained as a result of the failure of a counterparty to comply with the terms of a derivative instrument. The counterparty risk for exchange-traded derivative instruments is generally less than for privately-negotiated or OTC derivative instruments, since generally a clearing agency, which is the issuer or counterparty to each exchange-traded instrument, provides a guarantee of performance. For privately-negotiated instruments, there is no similar clearing agency guarantee. In all transactions, an investor will bear the risk that the counterparty will default, and this could result in a loss of the expected benefit of the derivative transaction and possibly other losses.

When a derivative transaction is used to completely hedge another position, changes in the market value of the combined position (the derivative instrument plus the position being hedged) result from an imperfect correlation between the price movements of the two instruments. With a perfect hedge, the value of the combined position remains unchanged for any change in the price of the underlying asset. With an imperfect hedge, the values of the derivative instrument and its hedge are not perfectly correlated. For example, if the value of a derivative instrument used in a short hedge (such as writing a call option, buying a put option, or selling a futures contract) increased by less than the decline in value of the hedged investment, the hedge would not be perfectly correlated. Such a lack of correlation might occur due to factors unrelated to the value of the investments being hedged, such as speculative or other pressures on the markets in which these instruments are traded.

Derivatives also are subject to the risk that they cannot be sold, closed out, or replaced quickly at or very close to their fundamental value. Generally, exchange contracts are very liquid because the exchange clearinghouse is the counterparty of every contract. OTC transactions are less liquid than exchange-traded derivatives since they often can only be closed out with the other party to the transaction.

Another risk is caused by the legal unenforcibility of a party’s obligations under the derivative. A counterparty that has lost money in a derivative transaction may try to avoid payment by exploiting various legal uncertainties about certain derivative products.

(See also Foreign Currency Transactions.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with derivative instruments include: Derivatives Risk and Liquidity Risk.

Exchange-Traded Funds

Exchange-traded funds (ETFs) represent shares of ownership in funds, unit investment trusts or depositary receipts. ETFs hold portfolios of securities that are designed to replicate, as closely as possible before expenses, the price and yield of a specified market index. The performance results of ETFs will not replicate exactly the performance of the pertinent index due to transaction and other expenses, including fees to service providers, borne by ETFs. ETF shares are sold and redeemed at net asset value only in large blocks called creation units and redemption units, respectively. The funds’ ability to redeem

 

27


Table of Contents

redemption units may be limited by the 1940 Act, which provides that ETFs will not be obligated to redeem shares held by the funds in an amount exceeding one percent of their total outstanding securities during any period of less than 30 days. There is a risk that Underlying ETFs in which a fund invests may terminate due to extraordinary events. ETF shares also may be purchased and sold in secondary market trading on national securities exchanges, which allows investors to purchase and sell ETF shares at their market price throughout the day.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, investments in ETFs involve the same risks associated with a direct investment in the types of securities included in the indices the ETFs are designed to replicate, including Market Risk. ETFs generally use a “passive” investment strategy and will not attempt to take defensive positions in volatile or declining markets. Shares of an ETF may trade at a market price that is less than their net asset value and an active trading market in such shares may not develop or continue and may be halted or interrupted due to actions by its listing exchange, unusual market conditions or other reasons. For example, any of the service providers to ETFs, such as the trustee or sponsor, may close or otherwise fail to perform their obligations to the ETF, and the ETF may not be able to find a substitute service provider. Also, ETFs may be dependent upon licenses to use the various indices as a basis for determining their compositions and/or otherwise to use certain trade names. If these licenses are terminated, the ETFs may also terminate. In addition, an ETF may terminate if its net assets fall below a certain amount. Although the funds believe that, in the event of the termination of an ETF, they will be able to invest instead in shares of an alternate ETF tracking the same market index or another index covering the same general market, there can be no assurance that shares of an alternate ETF would be available for investment at that time. There can be no assurance an ETF’s shares will continue to be listed on an active exchange. Finally, there can be no assurance that the portfolio of securities purchased by an ETF to replicate a particular index will replicate such index.

Generally, under the 1940 Act, a fund may not acquire shares of another investment company (including ETFs) if, immediately after such acquisition, (i) such fund would hold more than 3% of the other investment company’s total outstanding shares, (ii) if such fund’s investment in securities of the other investment company would be more than 5% of the value of the total assets of the Fund, or (iii) if more than 10% of such fund’s total assets would be invested in investment companies. The SEC has granted orders for exemptive relief to certain ETFs that permit investments in those ETFs by other investment companies (such as the Seligman TargETFunds) in excess of these limits. The Seligman TargETFunds’ ability to invest in ETFs will be severely constrained unless ETFs have received such an order from the SEC, and the ETF and the Seligman TargETFunds take appropriate steps to comply with the relevant terms and conditions of such orders.

The Seligman TargETFunds will invest in an ETF only if the SEC has issued an exemptive order to the ETF which permits investment companies, including the Seligman TargETFunds, to invest in ETFs beyond the limitations in the 1940 Act, subject to certain terms and conditions, including that such investment companies enter into an agreement with the ETF before investing in them in excess of the 3% limitation in the 1940 Act. To the extent other ETFs obtain similar exemptive relief from the SEC, the Seligman TargETFunds may seek to qualify to invest in such other ETFs in excess of the 1940 Act limitations. Each Seligman TargETFund may invest greater than 25% of its assets in any one ETF, although no Seligman TargETFund intends to invest greater than 40% of its assets in any one ETF.

To the extent the 1940 Act limitations apply to an ETF, such limitations may prevent Seligman TargETFund from allocating its investments in the manner that the investment manager considers optimal, or cause the investment manager to select a similar index or sector-based mutual fund or other investment company (each, an “Other Investment Company”), or a basket of stocks (a group of securities related by index or sector that are pre-selected by, and made available through, certain brokers) (“Stock Baskets”) providing similar exposure as an alternative. The Seligman TargETFunds may also invest in Other Investment Companies or Stock Baskets when the investment manager believes they represent more attractive opportunities than similar ETFs held in the portfolio.

ETFs, because they invest in other securities (e.g., common stocks of small-, mid- and large capitalization companies (U.S. and foreign, including, for example, real estate investment trusts and emerging markets securities) and fixed income securities), are subject to the risks of investment associated with these and other types of investments, as described in this SAI.

Floating Rate Loans

Most floating rate loans are acquired directly from the agent bank or from another holder of the loan by assignment. Most such loans are secured, and most impose restrictive covenants which must be met by the borrower. These loans are typically made by a syndicate of banks and institutional investors, represented by an agent bank which has negotiated and structured the loan and which is responsible generally for collecting interest, principal, and other amounts from the borrower on its own behalf and on behalf of the other lending institutions in the syndicate, and for enforcing its and their other rights against the borrower. Each of the lending institutions, including the agent bank, lends to the borrower a portion of the total amount of

 

28


Table of Contents

the loan, and retains the corresponding interest in the loan. Floating rate loans may include delayed draw term loans and prefunded or synthetic letters of credit.

A fund’s ability to receive payments of principal and interest and other amounts in connection with loans held by it will depend primarily on the financial condition of the borrower. The failure by the fund to receive scheduled interest or principal payments on a loan would adversely affect the income of the fund and would likely reduce the value of its assets, which would be reflected in a reduction in the fund’s net asset value. Banks and other lending institutions generally perform a credit analysis of the borrower before originating a loan or purchasing an assignment in a loan. In selecting the loans in which the fund will invest, however, the investment manager will not rely on that credit analysis of the agent bank, but will perform its own investment analysis of the borrowers. The investment manager’s analysis may include consideration of the borrower’s financial strength and managerial experience, debt coverage, additional borrowing requirements or debt maturity schedules, changing financial conditions, and responsiveness to changes in business conditions and interest rates. The majority of loans the fund will invest in will be rated by one or more of the nationally recognized rating agencies. Investments in loans may be of any quality, including “distressed” loans, and will be subject to the fund’s credit quality policy.

Loans may be structured in different forms, including assignments and participations. In an assignment, a fund purchases an assignment of a portion of a lender’s interest in a loan. In this case, the fund may be required generally to rely upon the assigning bank to demand payment and enforce its rights against the borrower, but would otherwise be entitled to all of such bank’s rights in the loan.

The borrower of a loan may, either at its own election or pursuant to terms of the loan documentation, prepay amounts of the loan from time to time. There is no assurance that a fund will be able to reinvest the proceeds of any loan prepayment at the same interest rate or on the same terms as those of the original loan.

Corporate loans in which a fund may purchase a loan assignment are made generally to finance internal growth, mergers, acquisitions, recapitalizations, stock repurchases, leveraged buy-outs, dividend payments to sponsors and other corporate activities. The highly leveraged capital structure of certain borrowers may make such loans especially vulnerable to adverse changes in economic or market conditions. The fund may hold investments in loans for a very short period of time when opportunities to resell the investments that the investment manager believes are attractive arise.

Certain of the loans acquired by a fund may involve revolving credit facilities under which a borrower may from time to time borrow and repay amounts up to the maximum amount of the facility. In such cases, the fund would have an obligation to advance its portion of such additional borrowings upon the terms specified in the loan assignment. To the extent that the fund is committed to make additional loans under such an assignment, it will at all times designate cash or securities in an amount sufficient to meet such commitments.

Notwithstanding its intention in certain situations to not receive material, non-public information with respect to its management of investments in floating rate loans, the investment manager may from time to time come into possession of material, non-public information about the issuers of loans that may be held in a fund’s portfolio. Possession of such information may in some instances occur despite the investment manager’s efforts to avoid such possession, but in other instances the investment manager may choose to receive such information (for example, in connection with participation in a creditors’ committee with respect to a financially distressed issuer). As, and to the extent, required by applicable law, the investment manager’s ability to trade in these loans for the account of the fund could potentially be limited by its possession of such information. Such limitations on the investment manager’s ability to trade could have an adverse effect on the fund by, for example, preventing the fund from selling a loan that is experiencing a material decline in value. In some instances, these trading restrictions could continue in effect for a substantial period of time.

In some instances, other accounts managed by the investment manager may hold other securities issued by borrowers whose floating rate loans may be held in a fund’s portfolio. These other securities may include, for example, debt securities that are subordinate to the floating rate loans held in the fund’s portfolio, convertible debt or common or preferred equity securities. In certain circumstances, such as if the credit quality of the issuer deteriorates, the interests of holders of these other securities may conflict with the interests of the holders of the issuer’s floating rate loans. In such cases, the investment manager may owe conflicting fiduciary duties to the fund and other client accounts. The investment manager will endeavor to carry out its obligations to all of its clients to the fullest extent possible, recognizing that in some cases certain clients may achieve a lower economic return, as a result of these conflicting client interests, than if the investment manager’s client accounts collectively held only a single category of the issuer’s securities.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with floating rate loans include: Credit Risk and Prepayment and Extension Risk.

 

29


Table of Contents

 

Foreign Currency Transactions

Investments in foreign securities usually involve currencies of foreign countries. In addition, a fund may hold cash and cash equivalent investments in foreign currencies. As a result, the value of a fund’s assets as measured in U.S. dollars may be affected favorably or unfavorably by changes in currency exchange rates and exchange control regulations. Also, a fund may incur costs in connection with conversions between various currencies. Currency exchange rates may fluctuate significantly over short periods of time causing a fund’s NAV (Net Asset Value) to fluctuate. Currency exchange rates are generally determined by the forces of supply and demand in the foreign exchange markets, actual or anticipated changes in interest rates, and other complex factors. Currency exchange rates also can be affected by the intervention of U.S. or foreign governments or central banks, or the failure to intervene, or by currency controls or political developments.

Spot Rates and Derivative Instruments. A fund may conduct its foreign currency exchange transactions either at the spot (cash) rate prevailing in the foreign currency exchange market or by entering into forward currency exchange contracts (forward contracts). (See also Derivative Instruments.) These contracts are traded in the interbank market conducted directly between currency traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers. Because foreign currency transactions occurring in the interbank market might involve substantially larger amounts than those involved in the use of such derivative instruments, a fund could be disadvantaged by having to deal in the odd lot market for the underlying foreign currencies at prices that are less favorable than for round lots.

A fund may enter into forward contracts for a variety of reasons, but primarily it will enter into such contracts for risk management (hedging) or for investment purposes.

A fund may enter into forward contracts to settle a security transaction or handle dividend and interest collection. When a fund enters into a contract for the purchase or sale of a security denominated in a foreign currency or has been notified of a dividend or interest payment, it may desire to lock in the price of the security or the amount of the payment, usually in U.S. dollars, although it could desire to lock in the price of the security in another currency. By entering into a forward contract, a fund would be able to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an adverse change in the relationship between different currencies from the date the security is purchased or sold to the date on which payment is made or received or when the dividend or interest is actually received.

A fund may enter into forward contracts when management of the fund believes the currency of a particular foreign country may decline in value relative to another currency. When selling currencies forward in this fashion, a fund may seek to hedge the value of foreign securities it holds against an adverse move in exchange rates. The precise matching of forward contract amounts and the value of securities involved generally will not be possible since the future value of securities in foreign currencies more than likely will change between the date the forward contract is entered into and the date it matures. The projection of short-term currency market movements is extremely difficult and successful execution of a short-term hedging strategy is highly uncertain. Unless specifically permitted, a fund would not enter into such forward contracts or maintain a net exposure to such contracts when consummating the contracts would obligate it to deliver an amount of foreign currency in excess of the value of its securities or other assets denominated in that currency.

This method of protecting the value of the fund’s securities against a decline in the value of a currency does not eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of the securities. It simply establishes a rate of exchange that can be achieved at some point in time. Although forward contracts tend to minimize the risk of loss due to a decline in value of hedged currency, they tend to limit any potential gain that might result should the value of such currency increase.

A fund may also enter into forward contracts when its management believes the currency of a particular country will increase in value relative to another currency. A fund may buy currencies forward to gain exposure to a currency without incurring the additional costs of purchasing securities denominated in that currency.

Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund is designed to invest in a combination of forward currency contracts and U.S. dollar-denominated market instruments in an attempt to obtain an investment result that is substantially the same as a direct investment in a foreign currency-denominated instrument. For example, the combination of U.S. dollar-denominated instruments with long forward currency exchange contracts creates a position economically equivalent to a position in the foreign currency, in anticipation of an increase in the value of the foreign currency against the U.S. dollar. Conversely, the combination of U.S. dollar-denominated instruments with short forward currency exchange contracts is economically equivalent to borrowing the foreign currency for delivery at a specified date in the future, in anticipation of a decrease in the value of the foreign currency against the U.S. dollar. This strategy may also be employed by other funds. Unanticipated changes in the currency exchange results could result in poorer performance for funds that enter into these types of transactions.

A fund may designate cash or securities in an amount equal to the value of the fund’s total assets committed to consummating forward contracts entered into under the circumstance set forth above. If the value of the securities declines,

 

30


Table of Contents

additional cash or securities will be designated on a daily basis so that the value of the cash or securities will equal the amount of the fund’s commitments on such contracts.

At maturity of a forward contract, a fund may either deliver (if a contract to sell) or take delivery of (if a contract to buy) the foreign currency or terminate its contractual obligation by entering into an offsetting contract with the same currency trader, the same maturity date, and covering the same amount of foreign currency.

If a fund engages in an offsetting transaction, it would incur a gain or loss to the extent there has been movement in forward contract prices. If a fund engages in an offsetting transaction, it may subsequently enter into a new forward contract to buy or sell the foreign currency.

Although a fund values its assets each business day in terms of U.S. dollars, it may not intend to convert its foreign currencies into U.S. dollars on a daily basis. It would do so from time to time, and shareholders should be aware of currency conversion costs. Although foreign exchange dealers do not charge a fee for conversion, they do realize a profit based on the difference (spread) between the prices at which they are buying and selling various currencies. Thus, a dealer may offer to sell a foreign currency to a fund at one rate, while offering a lesser rate of exchange should a fund desire to resell that currency to the dealer.

For Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund, it is possible, under certain circumstances, including entering into forward currency contracts for investment purposes, that the fund may have to limit or restructure its forward contract currency transactions to qualify as a “regulated investment company” under the Internal Revenue Code.

Options on Foreign Currencies. A fund may buy put and call options and write covered call and cash-secured put options on foreign currencies for hedging purposes and to gain exposure to foreign currencies. For example, a decline in the dollar value of a foreign currency in which securities are denominated will reduce the dollar value of such securities, even if their value in the foreign currency remains constant. In order to protect against the diminutions in the value of securities, a fund may buy put options on the foreign currency. If the value of the currency does decline, a fund would have the right to sell the currency for a fixed amount in dollars and would offset, in whole or in part, the adverse effect on its portfolio that otherwise would have resulted.

Conversely, where a change in the dollar value of a currency would increase the cost of securities a fund plans to buy, or where a fund would benefit from increased exposure to the currency, a fund may buy call options on the foreign currency. The purchase of the options could offset, at least partially, the changes in exchange rates.

As in the case of other types of options, however, the benefit to a fund derived from purchases of foreign currency options would be reduced by the amount of the premium and related transaction costs. In addition, where currency exchange rates do not move in the direction or to the extent anticipated, a fund could sustain losses on transactions in foreign currency options that would require it to forego a portion or all of the benefits of advantageous changes in rates.

A fund may write options on foreign currencies for the same types of purposes. For example, when a fund anticipates a decline in the dollar value of foreign-denominated securities due to adverse fluctuations in exchange rates it could, instead of purchasing a put option, write a call option on the relevant currency. If the expected decline occurs, the option would most likely not be exercised and the diminution in value of securities would be fully or partially offset by the amount of the premium received.

Similarly, instead of purchasing a call option when a foreign currency is expected to appreciate, a fund could write a put option on the relevant currency. If rates move in the manner projected, the put option would expire unexercised and allow the fund to hedge increased cost up to the amount of the premium.

As in the case of other types of options, however, the writing of a foreign currency option will constitute only a partial hedge up to the amount of the premium, and only if rates move in the expected direction. If this does not occur, the option may be exercised and the fund would be required to buy or sell the underlying currency at a loss that may not be offset by the amount of the premium. Through the writing of options on foreign currencies, the fund also may be required to forego all or a portion of the benefits that might otherwise have been obtained from favorable movements on exchange rates.

All options written on foreign currencies will be covered. An option written on foreign currencies is covered if a fund holds currency sufficient to cover the option or has an absolute and immediate right to acquire that currency without additional cash consideration upon conversion of assets denominated in that currency or exchange of other currency held in its portfolio. An option writer could lose amounts substantially in excess of its initial investments, due to the margin and collateral requirements associated with such positions.

Options on foreign currencies are traded through financial institutions acting as market-makers, although foreign currency options also are traded on certain national securities exchanges, such as the Philadelphia Stock Exchange and the Chicago Board Options Exchange, subject to SEC regulation. In an over-the-counter trading environment, many of the protections

 

31


Table of Contents

afforded to exchange participants will not be available. For example, there are no daily price fluctuation limits, and adverse market movements could therefore continue to an unlimited extent over a period of time. Although the purchaser of an option cannot lose more than the amount of the premium plus related transaction costs, this entire amount could be lost.

Foreign currency option positions entered into on a national securities exchange are cleared and guaranteed by the Options Clearing Corporation (OCC), thereby reducing the risk of counterparty default. Further, a liquid secondary market in options traded on a national securities exchange may be more readily available than in the over-the-counter market, potentially permitting a fund to liquidate open positions at a profit prior to exercise or expiration, or to limit losses in the event of adverse market movements.

The purchase and sale of exchange-traded foreign currency options, however, is subject to the risks of availability of a liquid secondary market described above, as well as the risks regarding adverse market movements, margining of options written, the nature of the foreign currency market, possible intervention by governmental authorities and the effects of other political and economic events. In addition, exchange-traded options on foreign currencies involve certain risks not presented by the over-the-counter market. For example, exercise and settlement of such options must be made exclusively through the OCC, which has established banking relationships in certain foreign countries for that purpose. As a result, the OCC may, if it determines that foreign governmental restrictions or taxes would prevent the orderly settlement of foreign currency option exercises, or would result in undue burdens on OCC or its clearing member, impose special procedures on exercise and settlement, such as technical changes in the mechanics of delivery of currency, the fixing of dollar settlement prices or prohibitions on exercise.

Foreign Currency Futures and Related Options. A fund may enter into currency futures contracts to buy or sell currencies. It also may buy put and call options and write covered call and cash-secured put options on currency futures. Currency futures contracts are similar to currency forward contracts, except that they are traded on exchanges (and have margin requirements) and are standardized as to contract size and delivery date. Most currency futures call for payment of delivery in U.S. dollars. A fund may use currency futures for the same purposes as currency forward contracts, subject to CFTC limitations.

Currency futures and options on futures values can be expected to correlate with exchange rates, but will not reflect other factors that may affect the value of the fund’s investments. A currency hedge, for example, should protect a Yen-denominated bond against a decline in the Yen, but will not protect a fund against price decline if the issuer’s creditworthiness deteriorates. Because the value of a fund’s investments denominated in foreign currency will change in response to many factors other than exchange rates, it may not be possible to match the amount of a forward contract to the value of a fund’s investments denominated in that currency over time.

A fund will hold securities or other options or futures positions whose values are expected to offset its obligations. The fund would not enter into an option or futures position that exposes the fund to an obligation to another party unless it owns either (i) an offsetting position in securities or (ii) cash, receivables and short-term debt securities with a value sufficient to cover its potential obligations. (See also Derivative Instruments and Foreign Securities.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with foreign currency transactions include: Derivatives Risk, Interest Rate Risk, and Liquidity Risk.

Foreign Securities

Foreign securities, foreign currencies, and securities issued by U.S. entities with substantial foreign operations involve special risks, including those set forth below, which are not typically associated with investing in U.S. securities. Foreign companies are not generally subject to uniform accounting, auditing, and financial reporting standards comparable to those applicable to domestic companies. Additionally, many foreign stock markets, while growing in volume of trading activity, have substantially less volume than the New York Stock Exchange, and securities of some foreign companies are less liquid and more volatile than securities of domestic companies. Similarly, volume and liquidity in most foreign bond markets are less than the volume and liquidity in the U.S. and, at times, volatility of price can be greater than in the U.S. Further, foreign markets have different clearance, settlement, registration, and communication procedures and in certain markets there have been times when settlements have been unable to keep pace with the volume of securities transactions making it difficult to conduct such transactions. Delays in such procedures could result in temporary periods when assets are uninvested and no return is earned on them. The inability of an investor to make intended security purchases due to such problems could cause the investor to miss attractive investment opportunities.

Payment for securities without delivery may be required in certain foreign markets and, when participating in new issues, some foreign countries require payment to be made in advance of issuance (at the time of issuance, the market value of the security may be more or less than the purchase price). Some foreign markets also have compulsory depositories (i.e., an investor does not have a choice as to where the securities are held). Fixed commissions on some foreign stock exchanges are generally higher than negotiated commissions on U.S. exchanges. Further, an investor may encounter difficulties or be unable

 

32


Table of Contents

to pursue legal remedies and obtain judgments in foreign courts. There is generally less government supervision and regulation of business and industry practices, stock exchanges, brokers, and listed companies than in the U.S. It may be more difficult for an investor’s agents to keep currently informed about corporate actions such as stock dividends or other matters that may affect the prices of portfolio securities. Communications between the U.S. and foreign countries may be less reliable than within the U.S., thus increasing the risk of delays or loss of certificates for portfolio securities. In addition, with respect to certain foreign countries, there is the possibility of nationalization, expropriation, the imposition of additional withholding or confiscatory taxes, political, social, or economic instability, diplomatic developments that could affect investments in those countries, or other unforeseen actions by regulatory bodies (such as changes to settlement or custody procedures).

The risks of foreign investing may be magnified for investments in emerging markets, which may have relatively unstable governments, economies based on only a few industries, and securities markets that trade a small number of securities.

The introduction of a single currency, the euro, on Jan. 1, 1999 for participating European nations in the Economic and Monetary Union (EU) presents unique uncertainties, including the legal treatment of certain outstanding financial contracts after Jan. 1, 1999 that refer to existing currencies rather than the euro; the establishment and maintenance of exchange rates; the fluctuation of the euro relative to non-euro currencies; whether the interest rate, tax or labor regimes of European countries participating in the euro will converge over time; and whether the admission of other countries such as Poland, Latvia, and Lithuania as members of the EU may have an impact on the euro.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with foreign securities include: Foreign/Emerging Markets Risk and Issuer Risk.

Funding Agreements

A fund may invest in funding agreements issued by domestic insurance companies. Funding agreements are short-term, privately placed, debt obligations of insurance companies that offer a fixed- or floating-rate of interest. These investments are not readily marketable and therefore are considered to be illiquid securities. (See also Illiquid and Restricted Securities.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with funding agreements include: Credit Risk and Liquidity Risk.

High-Yield Debt Securities (Junk Bonds)

High yield (high-risk) debt securities are sometimes referred to as junk bonds. They are non-investment grade (lower quality) securities that have speculative characteristics. Lower quality securities, while generally offering higher yields than investment grade securities with similar maturities, involve greater risks, including the possibility of default or bankruptcy. They are regarded as predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The special risk considerations in connection with investments in these securities are discussed below.

See Appendix A for a discussion of securities ratings. (See also Debt Obligations.)

All fixed rate interest-bearing securities typically experience appreciation when interest rates decline and depreciation when interest rates rise. The market values of lower-quality and comparable unrated securities tend to reflect individual corporate developments to a greater extent than do higher rated securities, which react primarily to fluctuations in the general level of interest rates. Lower-quality and comparable unrated securities also tend to be more sensitive to economic conditions than are higher-rated securities. As a result, they generally involve more credit risks than securities in the higher-rated categories. During an economic downturn or a sustained period of rising interest rates, highly leveraged issuers of lower-quality securities may experience financial stress and may not have sufficient revenues to meet their payment obligations. The issuer’s ability to service its debt obligations also may be adversely affected by specific corporate developments, the issuer’s inability to meet specific projected business forecasts, or the unavailability of additional financing. The risk of loss due to default by an issuer of these securities is significantly greater than a default by issuers of higher-rated securities because such securities are generally unsecured and are often subordinated to other creditors. Further, if the issuer of a lower quality security defaulted, an investor might incur additional expenses to seek recovery.

Credit ratings issued by credit rating agencies are designed to evaluate the safety of principal and interest payments of rated securities. They do not, however, evaluate the market value risk of lower-quality securities and, therefore, may not fully reflect the true risks of an investment. In addition, credit rating agencies may or may not make timely changes in a rating to reflect changes in the economy or in the condition of the issuer that affect the market value of the securities. Consequently, credit ratings are used only as a preliminary indicator of investment quality.

An investor may have difficulty disposing of certain lower-quality and comparable unrated securities because there may be a thin trading market for such securities. Because not all dealers maintain markets in all lower quality and comparable unrated securities, there is no established retail secondary market for many of these securities. To the extent a secondary trading

 

33


Table of Contents

market does exist, it is generally not as liquid as the secondary market for higher-rated securities. The lack of a liquid secondary market may have an adverse impact on the market price of the security. The lack of a liquid secondary market for certain securities also may make it more difficult for an investor to obtain accurate market quotations. Market quotations are generally available on many lower-quality and comparable unrated issues only from a limited number of dealers and may not necessarily represent firm bids of such dealers or prices for actual sales.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with high-yield debt securities include: Credit Risk, Interest Rate Risk, and Prepayment and Extension Risk.

Illiquid and Restricted Securities

Illiquid securities are securities that are not readily marketable. These securities may include, but are not limited to, certain securities that are subject to legal or contractual restrictions on resale, certain repurchase agreements, and derivative instruments. To the extent a fund invests in illiquid or restricted securities, it may encounter difficulty in determining a market value for the securities. Disposing of illiquid or restricted securities may involve time-consuming negotiations and legal expense, and it may be difficult or impossible for a fund to sell the investment promptly and at an acceptable price.

In determining the liquidity of all securities and derivatives, such as Rule 144A securities, which are unregistered securities offered to qualified institutional buyers, and interest-only and principal-only fixed mortgage-backed securities (IOs and POs) issued by the U.S. government or its agencies and instrumentalities the investment manager, under guidelines established by the Board, will consider any relevant factors including the frequency of trades, the number of dealers willing to purchase or sell the security and the nature of marketplace trades.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with illiquid and restricted securities include: Liquidity Risk.

Indexed Securities

The value of indexed securities is linked to currencies, interest rates, commodities, indexes, or other financial indicators. Most indexed securities are short- to intermediate-term fixed income securities whose values at maturity or interest rates rise or fall according to the change in one or more specified underlying instruments. Indexed securities may be more volatile than the underlying instrument itself and they may be less liquid than the securities represented by the index. (See also Derivative Instruments.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with indexed securities include: Liquidity Risk and Market Risk.

Inflation Protected Securities

Inflation is a general rise in prices of goods and services. Inflation erodes the purchasing power of an investor’s assets. For example, if an investment provides a total return of 7% in a given year and inflation is 3% during that period, the inflation-adjusted, or real, return is 4%. Inflation-protected securities are debt securities whose principal and/or interest payments are adjusted for inflation, unlike debt securities that make fixed principal and interest payments. One type of inflation-protected debt security is issued by the U.S. Treasury. The principal of these securities is adjusted for inflation as indicated by the Consumer Price Index for Urban Consumers (CPI) and interest is paid on the adjusted amount. The CPI is a measurement of changes in the cost of living, made up of components such as housing, food, transportation and energy.

If the CPI falls, the principal value of inflation-protected securities will be adjusted downward, and consequently the interest payable on these securities (calculated with respect to a smaller principal amount) will be reduced. Conversely, if the CPI rises, the principal value of inflation-protected securities will be adjusted upward, and consequently the interest payable on these securities will be increased. Repayment of the original bond principal upon maturity is guaranteed in the case of U.S. Treasury inflation-protected securities, even during a period of deflation. However, the current market value of the inflation-protected securities is not guaranteed and will fluctuate. Other inflation-indexed securities include inflation-related bonds, which may or may not provide a similar guarantee. If a guarantee of principal is not provided, the adjusted principal value of the bond repaid at maturity may be less than the original principal.

Other issuers of inflation-protected debt securities include other U.S. government agencies or instrumentalities, corporations and foreign governments. There can be no assurance that the CPI or any foreign inflation index will accurately measure the real rate of inflation in the prices of goods and services. Moreover, there can be no assurance that the rate of inflation in a foreign country will be correlated to the rate of inflation in the United States.

If interest rates rise due to reasons other than inflation (for example, due to changes in currency exchange rates), investors in these securities may not be protected to the extent that the increase is not reflected in the bond’s inflation measure.

 

34


Table of Contents

 

Any increase in principal for an inflation-protected security resulting from inflation adjustments is considered by IRS regulations to be taxable income in the year it occurs. For direct holders of an inflation-protected security, this means that taxes must be paid on principal adjustments even though these amounts are not received until the bond matures. By contrast, a fund holding these securities distributes both interest income and the income attributable to principal adjustments in the form of cash or reinvested shares, which are taxable to shareholders.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with inflation-protected securities include: Interest Rate Risk and Market Risk.

Initial Public Offerings (IPOs)

Companies issuing IPOs generally have limited operating histories, and their prospects for future profitability are uncertain. These companies often are engaged in new and evolving businesses and are particularly vulnerable to competition and to changes in technology, markets and economic conditions. They may be dependent on certain key managers and third parties, need more personnel and other resources to manage growth and require significant additional capital. They may also be dependent on limited product lines and uncertain property rights and need regulatory approvals. Funds that invest in IPOs can be affected by sales of additional shares and by concentration of control in existing management and principal shareholders. Stock prices of IPOs can also be highly unstable, due to the absence of a prior public market, the small number of shares available for trading and limited investor information. Most IPOs involve a high degree of risk not normally associated with offerings of more seasoned companies.

Although one or more risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with IPOs include: Small and Mid-Sized Company Risk and Initial Public Offering (IPO) Risk.

Inverse Floaters

Inverse floaters or inverse floating rate securities are a type of derivative long-term fixed income obligation with a floating or variable interest rate that moves in the opposite direction of short-term interest rates. As short-term interest rates go down, the holders of the inverse floaters receive more income and, as short-term interest rates go up, the holders of the inverse floaters receive less income. As with all long-term fixed income securities, the price of the inverse floater moves inversely with long-term interest rates; as long-term interest rates go down, the price of the inverse floater moves up and, when long-term interest rates go up, the price of the inverse floater moves down. While inverse floater securities tend to provide more income than similar term and credit quality fixed-rate bonds, they also exhibit greater volatility in price movement (both up and down).

In the municipal market an inverse floater is typically created when the owner of a municipal fixed rate bond transfers that bond to a trust in exchange for cash and a residual interest in the trust’s assets and cash flows (inverse floater certificates). The trust funds the purchase of the bond by issuing two classes of certificates: short-term floating rate notes (typically sold to third parties) and the inverse floaters (also known as residual certificates). No additional income beyond that provided by the trust’s underlying bond is created; rather, that income is merely divided-up between the two classes of certificates. The holder of the inverse floating rate securities typically has the right to (1) cause the holders of the short-term floating rate notes to tender their notes at par ($100) and (2) to return the inverse floaters and withdraw the underlying bonds, thereby collapsing the trust. (See also Derivative Instruments.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with transactions in inverse floaters include: Interest Rate Risk, Credit Risk, Liquidity Risk and Market Risk.

Investment Companies

Investing in securities issued by registered and unregistered investment companies may involve the duplication of advisory fees and certain other expenses.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with the securities of other investment companies include: Market Risk.

Lending of Portfolio Securities

To generate additional income, a fund may lend up to one-third of the value of its total assets to broker-dealers, banks or other institutional borrowers of securities. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. serves as lending agent (the Lending Agent) to the funds pursuant to a securities lending agreement (the Securities Lending Agreement) approved by the Board.

Under the Securities Lending Agreement, the Lending Agent loans securities to approved borrowers pursuant to borrower agreements in exchange for collateral equal to at least 100% of the market value of the loaned securities. Collateral may consist of cash, securities issued by the U.S. government or its agencies or instrumentalities (collectively, “U.S. government securities”) or such other collateral as may be approved by the Board. For loans secured by cash, the fund retains the interest

 

35


Table of Contents

earned on cash collateral investments, but is required to pay the borrower a rebate for the use of the cash collateral. For loans secured by U.S. government securities, the borrower pays a borrower fee to the Lending Agent on behalf of the fund. If the market value of the loaned securities goes up, the Lending Agent will request additional collateral from the borrower. If the market value of the loaned securities goes down, the borrower may request that some collateral be returned. During the existence of the loan, the lender will receive from the borrower amounts equivalent to any dividends, interest or other distributions on the loaned securities, as well as interest on such amounts.

Loans are subject to termination by a fund or a borrower at any time. A fund may choose to terminate a loan in order to vote in a proxy solicitation if the fund has knowledge of a material event to be voted on that would affect the fund’s investment in the loaned security.

Securities lending involves counterparty risk, including the risk that a borrower may not provide additional collateral when required or return the loaned securities in a timely manner. Counterparty risk also includes a potential loss of rights in the collateral if the borrower or the Lending Agent defaults or fails financially. This risk is increased if a fund’s loans are concentrated with a single or limited number of borrowers. There are no limits on the number of borrowers a fund may use and a fund may lend securities to only one or a small group of borrowers. Funds participating in securities lending also bear the risk of loss in connection with investments of cash collateral received from the borrowers. Cash collateral is invested in accordance with investment guidelines contained in the Securities Lending Agreement and approved by the Board. To the extent that the value or return of a fund’s investments of the cash collateral declines below the amount owed to a borrower, a fund may incur losses that exceed the amount it earned on lending the security. The Lending Agent will indemnify a fund from losses resulting from a borrower’s failure to return a loaned security when due, but such indemnification does not extend to losses associated with declines in the value of cash collateral investments.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with the lending of portfolio securities include: Credit Risk.

Loan Participations

Loans, loan participations, and interests in securitized loan pools are interests in amounts owed by a corporate, governmental, or other borrower to a lender or consortium of lenders (typically banks, insurance companies, investment banks, government agencies, or international agencies). Loans involve a risk of loss in case of default or insolvency of the borrower and may offer less legal protection to an investor in the event of fraud or misrepresentation.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with loan participations include: Credit Risk.

Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Securities

Mortgage-backed securities represent direct or indirect participations in, or are secured by and payable from, mortgage loans secured by real property, and include single- and multi-class pass-through securities and Collateralized Mortgage Obligations (CMOs). These securities may be issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies or instrumentalities (see also Agency and Government Securities), or by private issuers, generally originators and investors in mortgage loans, including savings associations, mortgage bankers, commercial banks, investment bankers, and special purpose entities. Mortgage-backed securities issued by private lenders may be supported by pools of mortgage loans or other mortgage-backed securities that are guaranteed, directly or indirectly, by the U.S. government or one of its agencies or instrumentalities, or they may be issued without any governmental guarantee of the underlying mortgage assets but with some form of non-governmental credit enhancement. Commercial mortgage-backed securities (CMBS) are a specific type of mortgage-backed security collateralized by a pool of mortgages on commercial real estate.

Stripped mortgage-backed securities are a type of mortgage-backed security that receive differing proportions of the interest and principal payments from the underlying assets. Generally, there are two classes of stripped mortgage-backed securities: Interest Only (IO) and Principal Only (PO). IOs entitle the holder to receive distributions consisting of all or a portion of the interest on the underlying pool of mortgage loans or mortgage-backed securities. POs entitle the holder to receive distributions consisting of all or a portion of the principal of the underlying pool of mortgage loans or mortgage-backed securities. The cash flows and yields on IOs and POs are extremely sensitive to the rate of principal payments (including prepayments) on the underlying mortgage loans or mortgage-backed securities. A rapid rate of principal payments may adversely affect the yield to maturity of IOs. A slow rate of principal payments may adversely affect the yield to maturity of POs. If prepayments of principal are greater than anticipated, an investor in IOs may incur substantial losses. If prepayments of principal are slower than anticipated, the yield on a PO will be affected more severely than would be the case with a traditional mortgage-backed security.

CMOs are hybrid mortgage-related instruments secured by pools of mortgage loans or other mortgage-related securities, such as mortgage pass through securities or stripped mortgage-backed securities. CMOs may be structured into multiple classes, often

 

36


Table of Contents

referred to as “tranches,” with each class bearing a different stated maturity and entitled to a different schedule for payments of principal and interest, including prepayments. Principal prepayments on collateral underlying a CMO may cause it to be retired substantially earlier than its stated maturity. The yield characteristics of mortgage-backed securities differ from those of other debt securities. Among the differences are that interest and principal payments are made more frequently on mortgage-backed securities, usually monthly, and principal may be repaid at any time. These factors may reduce the expected yield.

Asset-backed securities have structural characteristics similar to mortgage-backed securities. Asset-backed debt obligations represent direct or indirect participation in, or secured by and payable from, assets such as motor vehicle installment sales contracts, other installment loan contracts, home equity loans, leases of various types of property, and receivables from credit card or other revolving credit arrangements. The credit quality of most asset-backed securities depends primarily on the credit quality of the assets underlying such securities, how well the entity issuing the security is insulated from the credit risk of the originator or any other affiliated entities, and the amount and quality of any credit enhancement of the securities. Payments or distributions of principal and interest on asset- backed debt obligations may be supported by non-governmental credit enhancements including letters of credit, reserve funds, overcollateralization, and guarantees by third parties. The market for privately issued asset-backed debt obligations is smaller and less liquid than the market for government sponsored mortgage-backed securities. (See also Derivative Instruments.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with mortgage and asset-backed securities include: Credit Risk, Interest Rate Risk, Liquidity Risk, and Prepayment and Extension Risk.

Mortgage Dollar Rolls

Mortgage dollar rolls are investments in which an investor sells mortgage-backed securities for delivery in the current month and simultaneously contracts to purchase substantially similar securities on a specified future date. While an investor foregoes principal and interest paid on the mortgage-backed securities during the roll period, the investor is compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the lower price for the future purchase as well as by any interest earned on the proceeds of the initial sale. The investor also could be compensated through the receipt of fee income equivalent to a lower forward price.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with mortgage dollar rolls include: Credit Risk and Interest Rate Risk.

Municipal Obligations

Municipal obligations include debt obligations issued by or on behalf of states, territories, possessions, or sovereign nations within the territorial boundaries of the United States (including the District of Columbia, Guam and Puerto Rico). The interest on these obligations is generally exempt from federal income tax. Municipal obligations are generally classified as either “general obligations” or “revenue obligations.”

General obligation bonds are secured by the issuer’s pledge of its full faith, credit, and taxing power for the payment of interest and principal. Revenue bonds are payable only from the revenues derived from a project or facility or from the proceeds of a specified revenue source. Industrial development bonds are generally revenue bonds secured by payments from and the credit of private users. Municipal notes are issued to meet the short-term funding requirements of state, regional, and local governments. Municipal notes include tax anticipation notes, bond anticipation notes, revenue anticipation notes, tax and revenue anticipation notes, construction loan notes, short-term discount notes, tax-exempt commercial paper, demand notes, and similar instruments.

Municipal lease obligations may take the form of a lease, an installment purchase, or a conditional sales contract. They are issued by state and local governments and authorities to acquire land, equipment, and facilities. An investor may purchase these obligations directly, or it may purchase participation interests in such obligations. Municipal leases may be subject to greater risks than general obligation or revenue bonds. State constitutions and statutes set forth requirements that states or municipalities must meet in order to issue municipal obligations. Municipal leases may contain a covenant by the state or municipality to budget for and make payments due under the obligation. Certain municipal leases may, however, provide that the issuer is not obligated to make payments on the obligation in future years unless funds have been appropriated for this purpose each year.

Yields on municipal bonds and notes depend on a variety of factors, including money market conditions, municipal bond market conditions, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. The municipal bond market has a large number of different issuers, many having smaller sized bond issues, and a wide choice of different maturities within each issue. For these reasons, most municipal bonds do not trade on a daily basis and many trade only rarely. Because many of these bonds trade infrequently, the spread between the bid and offer may be wider and the time needed to develop a bid or an offer may be longer than other security markets. See Appendix A for a discussion of securities ratings. (See also Debt Obligations.)

 

37


Table of Contents

 

Taxable Municipal Obligations. There is another type of municipal obligation that is subject to federal income tax for a variety of reasons. These municipal obligations do not qualify for the federal income exemption because (a) they did not receive necessary authorization for tax-exempt treatment from state or local government authorities, (b) they exceed certain regulatory limitations on the cost of issuance for tax-exempt financing or (c) they finance public or private activities that do not qualify for the federal income tax exemption. These non-qualifying activities might include, for example, certain types of multi-family housing, certain professional and local sports facilities, refinancing of certain municipal debt, and borrowing to replenish a municipality’s underfunded pension plan.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with municipal obligations include: Credit Risk, Inflation Risk, Interest Rate Risk, and Market Risk.

Preferred Stock

Preferred stock is a type of stock that pays dividends at a specified rate and that has preference over common stock in the payment of dividends and the liquidation of assets. Preferred stock does not ordinarily carry voting rights.

The price of a preferred stock is generally determined by earnings, type of products or services, projected growth rates, experience of management, liquidity, and general market conditions of the markets on which the stock trades.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with preferred stock include: Issuer Risk and Market Risk.

Real Estate Investment Trusts

Real estate investment trusts (REITs) are pooled investment vehicles that manage a portfolio of real estate or real estate related loans to earn profits for their shareholders. REITs are generally classified as equity REITs, mortgage REITs or a combination of equity and mortgage REITs. Equity REITs invest the majority of their assets directly in real property, such as shopping centers, nursing homes, office buildings, apartment complexes, and hotels, and derive income primarily from the collection of rents. Equity REITs can also realize capital gains by selling properties that have appreciated in value. Mortgage REITs invest the majority of their assets in real estate mortgages and derive income from the collection of interest payments. REITs can be subject to extreme volatility due to fluctuations in the demand for real estate, changes in interest rates, and adverse economic conditions. Similar to investment companies, REITs are not taxed on income distributed to shareholders provided they comply with certain requirements under the tax law. The failure of a REIT to continue to qualify as a REIT for tax purposes can materially affect its value. A fund will indirectly bear its proportionate share of any expenses paid by a REIT in which it invests.

REITs often do not provide complete tax information until after the calendar year-end. Consequently, because of the delay, it may be necessary for a fund investing in REITs to request permission to extend the deadline for issuance of Forms 1099-DIV beyond January 31. In the alternative, amended Forms 1099-DIV may be sent.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with REITs include: Interest Rate Risk, Issuer Risk and Market Risk.

Repurchase Agreements

Repurchase agreements may be entered into with certain banks or non-bank dealers. In a repurchase agreement, the purchaser buys a security at one price, and at the time of sale, the seller agrees to repurchase the obligation at a mutually agreed upon time and price (usually within seven days). The repurchase agreement determines the yield during the purchaser’s holding period, while the seller’s obligation to repurchase is secured by the value of the underlying security. Repurchase agreements could involve certain risks in the event of a default or insolvency of the other party to the agreement, including possible delays or restrictions upon the purchaser’s ability to dispose of the underlying securities.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with repurchase agreements include: Credit Risk.

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

In a reverse repurchase agreement, an investor sells a security and enters into an agreement to repurchase the security at a specified future date and price. The investor generally retains the right to interest and principal payments on the security. Since the investor receives cash upon entering into a reverse repurchase agreement, it may be considered a borrowing. (See also Derivative Instruments.)

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with reverse repurchase agreements include: Credit Risk and Interest Rate Risk.

 

38


Table of Contents

 

Short Sales

In short-selling transactions, a fund sells a security it does not own in anticipation of a decline in the market value of the security. To complete the transaction, a fund must borrow the security to make delivery to the buyer. A fund is obligated to replace the security borrowed by purchasing it at the market price at the time of replacement. The price at such time may be more or less than the price at which the security was sold by a fund, which may result in a loss or gain, respectively. Unlike taking a long position in a security by purchasing the security, where potential losses are limited to the purchase price, short sales have no cap on maximum losses, and gains are limited to the price of the security at the time of the short sale.

Short sales of forward commitments and derivatives do not involve borrowing a security. These types of short sales may include futures, options, contracts for differences, forward contracts on financial instruments and options such as contracts, credit-linked instruments, and swap contracts.

A fund may not always be able to borrow a security it wants to sell short. A fund also may be unable to close out an established short position at an acceptable price and may have to sell long positions at disadvantageous times to cover its short positions. The value of your investment in a fund will fluctuate in response to the movements in the market. Fund performance also will depend on the effectiveness of the investment manager’s research and the management team’s investment decisions.

Short sales also involve other costs. A fund must repay to the lender an amount equal to any dividends or interest that accrues while the loan is outstanding. To borrow the security, a fund may be required to pay a premium. A fund also will incur truncation costs in effecting short sales. The amount of any ultimate gain for a fund resulting from a short sale will be decreased and the amount of any ultimate loss will be increased, by the amount of premiums, interest or expenses a fund may be required to pay in connection with the short sale. Until a fund closes the short position, it will earmark and reserve fund assets, in cash or liquid securities to offset a portion of the leverage risk. Realized gains from short sales are typically treated as short-term gains/losses.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with short sales include: Market Risk and Short Sales Risk.

Sovereign Debt

A sovereign debtor’s willingness or ability to repay principal and pay interest in a timely manner may be affected by a variety of factors, including its cash flow situation, the extent of its reserves, the availability of sufficient foreign exchange on the date a payment is due, the relative size of the debt service burden to the economy as a whole, the sovereign debtor’s policy toward international lenders, and the political constraints to which a sovereign debtor may be subject. (See also Foreign Securities.)

With respect to sovereign debt of emerging market issuers, investors should be aware that certain emerging market countries are among the largest debtors to commercial banks and foreign governments. At times, certain emerging market countries have declared moratoria on the payment of principal and interest on external debt.

Certain emerging market countries have experienced difficulty in servicing their sovereign debt on a timely basis that led to defaults and the restructuring of certain indebtedness.

Sovereign debt includes Brady Bonds, which are securities issued under the framework of the Brady Plan, an initiative announced by former U.S. Treasury Secretary Nicholas F. Brady in 1989 as a mechanism for debtor nations to restructure their outstanding external commercial bank indebtedness.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with sovereign debt include: Credit Risk and Foreign/Emerging Markets Risk.

Structured Investments

A structured investment is a security whose return is tied to an underlying index or to some other security or pool of assets. Structured investments generally are individually negotiated agreements and may be traded over-the-counter. Structured investments are created and operated to restructure the investment characteristics of the underlying security. This restructuring involves the deposit with or purchase by an entity, such as a corporation or trust, of specified instruments, such as commercial bank loans, and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of debt obligations (“structured securities”) backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying instruments. The cash flow on the underlying instruments may be apportioned among the newly issued structured securities to create securities with different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, payment priorities, and interest rate provisions. The extent of the payments made with respect to structured securities is dependent on the extent of the cash flow on the underlying instruments. Because structured securities typically involve no credit enhancement, their credit risk generally will be equivalent to that of the underlying instruments. Structured securities are often offered in different classes. As a result a given class of a structured security may be either

 

39


Table of Contents

subordinated or unsubordinated to the right of payment of another class. Subordinated structured securities typically have higher yields and present greater risks than unsubordinated structured securities. Structured securities are typically sold in private placement transactions, and at any given time there may be no active trading market for a particular structured security.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with structured investments include: Credit Risk and Liquidity Risk.

Swap Agreements

Swap agreements are typically individually negotiated agreements that obligate two parties to exchange payments based on a reference to a specified asset, reference rate or index. Swap agreements will tend to shift a party’s investment exposure from one type of investment to another. A swap agreement can increase or decrease the volatility of a fund’s investments and its net asset value.

Swap agreements are traded in the over-the-counter market and may be considered to be illiquid. Swap agreements entail the risk that a party will default on its payment obligations. A fund will enter into a swap agreement only if the claims-paying ability of the other party or its guarantor is considered to be investment grade by the investment manager. Generally, the unsecured senior debt or the claims-paying ability of the other party or its guarantor must be rated in one of the three highest rating categories of at least one Nationally Recognized Statistical Rating Organization (NRSRO) at the time of entering into the transaction. If there is a default by the other party to such a transaction, a fund will have to rely on its contractual remedies (which may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency or similar laws) pursuant to the agreements related to the transaction. In certain circumstances, a fund may seek to minimize counterparty risk by requiring the counterparty to post collateral.

Swap agreements are usually entered into without an upfront payment because the value of each party’s position is the same. The market values of the underlying commitments will change over time resulting in one of the commitments being worth more than the other and the net market value creating a risk exposure for one counterparty or the other.

Interest Rate Swaps. Interest rate swap agreements are often used to obtain or preserve a desired return or spread at a lower cost than through a direct investment in an instrument that yields the desired return or spread. They are financial instruments that involve the exchange of one type of interest rate cash flow for another type of interest rate cash flow on specified dates in the future. In a standard interest rate swap transaction, two parties agree to exchange their respective commitments to pay fixed or floating rates on a predetermined specified (notional) amount. The swap agreement notional amount is the predetermined basis for calculating the obligations that the swap counterparties have agreed to exchange. Under most swap agreements, the obligations of the parties are exchanged on a net basis. The two payment streams are netted out, with each party receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments. Interest rate swaps can be based on various measures of interest rates, including LIBOR, swap rates, treasury rates and other foreign interest rates.

Cross Currency Swaps. Cross currency swaps are similar to interest rate swaps, except that they involve multiple currencies. A fund may enter into a currency swap when it has exposure to one currency and desires exposure to a different currency. Typically the interest rates that determine the currency swap payments are fixed, although occasionally one or both parties may pay a floating rate of interest. Unlike an interest rate swap, however, the principal amounts are exchanged at the beginning of the contract and returned at the end of the contract. In addition to paying and receiving amounts at the beginning and termination of the agreements, both sides will also have to pay in full periodically based upon the currency they have borrowed. Change in foreign exchange rates and changes in interest rates, as described above, may negatively affect currency swaps.

Total Return Swaps. Total return swaps are contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments based on the change in market value of the underlying assets, which may include a specified security, basket of securities or security indexes during the specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate of the total return from other underlying assets. Total return swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or market. For example, CMBS total return swaps are bilateral financial contracts designed to replicate synthetically the total returns of commercial mortgage-backed securities. In a typical total return equity swap, payments made by the fund or the counterparty are based on the total return of a particular reference asset or assets (such as an equity security, a combination of such securities, or an index). That is, one party agrees to pay another party the return on a stock, basket of stocks, or stock index in return for a specified interest rate. By entering into an equity index swap, for example, the index receiver can gain exposure to stocks making up the index of securities without actually purchasing those stocks. Total return swaps involve not only the risk associated with the investment in the underlying securities, but also the risk of the counterparty not fulfilling its obligations under the agreement.

 

40


Table of Contents

 

Swaption Transaction. A swaption is an option on a swap agreement and a contract that gives a counterparty the right (but not the obligation) to enter into a new swap agreement or to shorten, extend, cancel or otherwise modify an existing swap agreement, at some designated future time on specified terms, in return for payment of the purchase price (the “premium”) of the option. The fund may write (sell) and purchase put and call swaptions to the same extent it may make use of standard options on securities or other instruments. The writer of the contract receives the premium and bears the risk of unfavorable changes in the market value on the underlying swap agreement.

Swaptions can be bundled and sold as a package. These are commonly called interest rate caps, floors and collars. In interest rate cap transactions, in return for a premium, one party agrees to make payments to the other to the extent that interest rates exceed a specified rate, or cap. Interest rate floor transactions require one party, in exchange for a premium to agree to make payments to the other to the extent that interest rates fall below a specified level, or floor. In interest rate collar transactions, one party sells a cap and purchases a floor, or vice versa, in an attempt to protect itself against interest rate movements exceeding given minimum or maximum levels or collar amounts.

Credit Default Swaps. Credit default swaps are contracts in which third party credit risk is transferred from one party to another party by one party, the protection buyer, making payments to the other party, the protection seller, in return for the ability of the protection buyer to deliver a reference obligation, or portfolio of reference obligations, to the protection seller upon the occurrence of certain credit events relating to the issuer of the reference obligation and receive the notional amount of the reference obligation from the protection seller. A fund may use credit default swaps for various purposes including to increase or decrease its credit exposure to various issuers. For example, as a seller in a transaction, a fund could use credit default swaps as a way of increasing investment exposure to a particular issuer’s bonds in lieu of purchasing such bonds directly. Similarly, as a buyer in a transaction, a fund may use credit default swaps to hedge its exposure on bonds that it owns or in lieu of selling such bonds. A credit default swap agreement may have as reference obligations one or more securities that are not currently held by the fund. The fund may be either the buyer or seller in the transaction. Credit default swaps may also be structured based on the debt of a basket of issuers, rather than a single issuer, and may be customized with respect to the default event that triggers purchase or other factors. As a seller, the fund generally receives an up front payment or a fixed rate of income throughout the term of the swap, which typically is between six months and three years, provided that there is no credit event. If a credit event occurs, generally the seller must pay the buyer the full face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference obligations that may have little or no value. If the fund is a buyer and no credit event occurs, the fund recovers nothing if the swap is held through its termination date. However, if a credit event occurs, the buyer may elect to receive the full notional value of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference obligation that may have little or no value.

Credit default swap agreements can involve greater risks than if a fund had invested in the reference obligation directly since, in addition to general market risks, credit default swaps are subject to counterparty credit risk, leverage risk, hedging risk, correlation risk and liquidity risk. A fund will enter into credit default swap agreements only with counterparties that meet certain standards of creditworthiness. A buyer generally also will lose its investment and recover nothing should no credit event occur and the swap is held to its termination date. If a credit event were to occur, the value of any deliverable obligation received by the seller, coupled with the upfront or periodic payments previously received, may be less than the full notional value it pays to the buyer, resulting in a loss of value to the seller. A fund’s obligations under a credit default swap agreement will be accrued daily (offset against any amounts owing to the fund). In connection with credit default swaps in which a fund is the buyer, the fund will segregate or “earmark” cash or other liquid assets, or enter into certain offsetting positions, with a value at least equal to the fund’s exposure (any accrued but unpaid net amounts owed by the fund to any counterparty), on a marked-to-market basis. In connection with credit default swaps in which a fund is the seller, the fund will segregate or “earmark” cash or other liquid assets, or enter into offsetting positions, with a value at least equal to the full notional amount of the swap (minus any amounts owed to the fund). Such segregation or “earmarking” will ensure that the fund has assets available to satisfy its obligations with respect to the transaction. Such segregation or “earmarking” will not limit the fund’s exposure to loss.

The use of swap agreements by a fund entails certain risks, which may be different from, or possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in the securities and other investments that are the referenced asset for the swap agreement. Swaps are highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques, risk analyses, and tax planning different from those associated with stocks, bonds, and other traditional investments. The use of a swap requires an understanding not only of the referenced asset, reference rate, or index, but also of the swap itself, without the benefit of observing the performance of the swap under all the possible market conditions. Because some swap agreements have a leverage component, adverse changes in the value or level of the underlying asset, reference rate, or index can result in a loss substantially greater than the amount invested in the swap itself. Certain swaps have the potential for unlimited loss, regardless of the size of the initial investment.

 

41


Table of Contents

 

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with swaps include: Credit Risk, Liquidity Risk and Market Risk.

Variable- or Floating-Rate Securities

Variable-rate securities provide for automatic establishment of a new interest rate at fixed intervals (daily, monthly, semiannually, etc.). Floating-rate securities generally provide for automatic adjustment of the interest rate whenever some specified interest rate index changes. Variable- or floating-rate securities frequently include a demand feature enabling the holder to sell the securities to the issuer at par. In many cases, the demand feature can be exercised at any time. Some securities that do not have variable or floating interest rates may be accompanied by puts producing similar results and price characteristics. Variable-rate demand notes include master demand notes that are obligations that permit the investor to invest fluctuating amounts, which may change daily without penalty, pursuant to direct arrangements between the investor as lender, and the borrower. The interest rates on these notes fluctuate from time to time. The issuer of such obligations normally has a corresponding right, after a given period, to prepay in its discretion the outstanding principal amount of the obligations plus accrued interest upon a specified number of days’ notice to the holders of such obligations. Because these obligations are direct lending arrangements between the lender and borrower, it is not contemplated that such instruments generally will be traded. There generally is not an established secondary market for these obligations. Accordingly, where these obligations are not secured by letters of credit or other credit support arrangements, the lender’s right to redeem is dependent on the ability of the borrower to pay principal and interest on demand. Such obligations frequently are not rated by credit rating agencies and may involve heightened risk of default by the issuer.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with variable- or floating-rate securities include: Credit Risk.

Warrants

Warrants are securities giving the holder the right, but not the obligation, to buy the stock of an issuer at a given price (generally higher than the value of the stock at the time of issuance) during a specified period or perpetually. Warrants may be acquired separately or in connection with the acquisition of securities. Warrants do not carry with them the right to dividends or voting rights and they do not represent any rights in the assets of the issuer. Warrants may be considered to have more speculative characteristics than certain other types of investments. In addition, the value of a warrant does not necessarily change with the value of the underlying securities, and a warrant ceases to have value if it is not exercised prior to its expiration date.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with warrants include: Market Risk.

When-Issued Securities and Forward Commitments

When-issued securities and forward commitments involve a commitment to purchase or sell specific securities at a predetermined price or yield in which payment and delivery take place after the customary settlement period for that type of security. Normally, the settlement date occurs within 45 days of the purchase although in some cases settlement may take longer. The investor does not pay for the securities or receive dividends or interest on them until the contractual settlement date. Such instruments involve the risk of loss if the value of the security to be purchased declines prior to the settlement date and the risk that the security will not be issued as anticipated. If the security is not issued as anticipated, a fund may lose the opportunity to obtain a price and yield considered to be advantageous.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with when-issued securities and forward commitments include: Credit Risk.

Zero-Coupon, Step-Coupon, and Pay-in-Kind Securities

These securities are debt obligations that do not make regular cash interest payments (see also Debt Obligations). Zero-coupon and step-coupon securities are sold at a deep discount to their face value because they do not pay interest until maturity. Pay-in-kind securities pay interest through the issuance of additional securities. Because these securities do not pay current cash income, the price of these securities can be extremely volatile when interest rates fluctuate. See Appendix A for a discussion of securities ratings.

Although one or more of the other risks described in this SAI may apply, the largest risks associated with zero- coupon, step-coupon, and pay-in-kind securities include: Credit Risk and Interest Rate Risk.

A fund cannot issue senior securities but this does not prohibit certain investment activities for which assets of the fund are set aside, or margin, collateral or escrow arrangements are established, to cover the related obligations. Examples of those

 

42


Table of Contents

activities include borrowing money, delayed-delivery and when-issued securities transactions, and contracts to buy or sell options, derivatives, and hedging instruments.

Securities Transactions

Except as otherwise noted, the description of policies and procedures in this section also applies to any fund subadviser. Subject to policies set by the Board, as well as the terms of the investment management services agreements, and subadviser agreements, as applicable, the investment manager or subadviser is authorized to determine, consistent with a fund’s investment objective and policies, which securities will be purchased, held, or sold. In determining where the buy and sell orders are to be placed, the investment manager has been directed to use its best efforts to obtain the best available price and the most favorable execution except where otherwise authorized by the Board.

Each fund, the investment manager, any subadviser and Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (principal underwriter and distributor of the funds) (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) has a strict Code of Ethics that prohibits affiliated personnel from engaging in personal investment activities that compete with or attempt to take advantage of planned portfolio transactions for the fund.

A fund’s securities may be traded on an agency basis with brokers or dealers or on a principal basis with dealers. In an agency trade, the broker-dealer generally is paid a commission. In a principal trade, the investment manager will trade directly with the issuer or with a dealer who buys or sells for its own account, rather than acting on behalf of another client. The investment manager may pay the dealer a commission or instead, the dealer’s profit, if any, is the difference, or spread, between the dealer’s purchase and sale price for the security.

Broker-Dealer Selection

In selecting broker-dealers to execute transactions, the investment manager and each subadviser will consider from among such factors as the ability to minimize trading costs, trading expertise, infrastructure, ability to provide information or services, financial condition, confidentiality, competitiveness of commission rates, evaluations of execution quality, promptness of execution, past history, ability to prospect for and find liquidity, difficulty of trade, security’s trading characteristics, size of order, liquidity of market, block trading capabilities, quality of settlement, specialized expertise, overall responsiveness, willingness to commit capital and research services provided.

The Board has adopted a policy prohibiting the investment manager, or any subadviser, from considering sales of shares of the funds as a factor in the selection of broker-dealers through which to execute securities transactions.

On a periodic basis, the investment manager makes a comprehensive review of the broker-dealers and the overall reasonableness of their commissions, including review by an independent third-party evaluator. The review evaluates execution, operational efficiency, and research services.

Commission Dollars

Broker-dealers typically provide a bundle of services including research and execution of transactions. The research provided can be either proprietary (created and provided by the broker-dealer) or third party (created by a third party but provided by the broker-dealer). Consistent with the interests of the fund, the investment manager and each subadviser may use broker-dealers who provide both types of research products and services in exchange for commissions, known as “soft dollars,” generated by transactions in fund accounts.

The receipt of research and brokerage products and services is used by the investment manager, and by each subadviser, to the extent it engages in such transactions, to supplement its own research and analysis activities, by receiving the views and information of individuals and research staffs of other securities firms, and by gaining access to specialized expertise on individual companies, industries, areas of the economy and market factors. Research and brokerage products and services may include reports on the economy, industries, sectors and individual companies or issuers; statistical information; accounting and tax law interpretations; political analyses; reports on legal developments affecting portfolio securities; information on technical market actions; credit analyses; on-line quotation systems; risk measurement; analyses of corporate responsibility issues; on-line news services; and financial and market database services. Research services may be used by the investment manager in providing advice to multiple accounts, including the funds (or by any subadviser to any other client of the subadviser) even though it is not possible to relate the benefits to any particular account or fund.

On occasion, it may be desirable to compensate a broker for research services or for brokerage services by paying a commission that might not otherwise be charged or a commission in excess of the amount another broker might charge. The Board has adopted a policy authorizing the investment manager to do so, to the extent authorized by law, if the investment manager or subadviser determines, in good faith, that such commission is reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage

 

43


Table of Contents

or research services provided by a broker or dealer, viewed either in the light of that transaction or the investment manager’s or subadviser’s overall responsibilities with respect to a fund and the other funds or accounts for which it acts as investment manager (or by any subadviser to any other client of that subadviser).

As a result of these arrangements, some portfolio transactions may not be effected at the lowest commission, but overall execution may be better. The investment manager and each subadviser have represented that under its procedures the amount of commission paid will be reasonable and competitive in relation to the value of the brokerage services and research products and services provided.

The investment manager or a subadviser may use step-out transactions. A “step-out” is an arrangement in which the investment manager or subadviser executes a trade through one broker-dealer but instructs that broker-dealer to step-out all or a part of the trade to another broker-dealer. The second broker-dealer will clear and settle, and receive commissions for, the stepped-out portion. The investment manager or subadviser may receive research products and services in connection with step-out transactions.

Use of fund commissions may create potential conflicts of interest between the investment manager or subadviser and a fund. However, the investment manager and each subadviser has policies and procedures in place intended to mitigate these conflicts and ensure that the use of fund commissions falls within the “safe harbor” of Section 28(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Some products and services may be used for both investment decision-making and non-investment decision-making purposes (“mixed use” items). The investment manager and each subadviser, to the extent it has mixed use items, has procedures in place to assure that fund commissions pay only for the investment decision-making portion of a mixed-use item.

Affiliate Transactions

Subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements, the fund may enter into transactions in which Ameriprise Financial and/or its affiliates, or companies that are deemed to be affiliates of the fund (e.g., due to, among other factors, their or their affiliates’ ownership or control of shares of the fund) may have an interest that potentially conflicts with the interests of the fund. For example, an affiliate of Ameriprise Financial may sell securities to the fund from an offering in which it is an underwriter or from securities that it owns as a dealer, subject to applicable legal and regulatory requirements. Applicable legal and regulatory requirements also may prevent the fund from engaging in transactions with an affiliate of the fund, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, or from participating in an investment opportunity in which an affiliate of the fund participates.

Trade Aggregation and Allocation

Generally, orders are processed and executed in the order received. When a fund buys or sells the same security as another portfolio, fund, or account, the investment manager or subadviser carries out the purchase or sale pursuant to policies and procedures designed in such a way believed to be fair to the fund. Purchase and sale orders may be combined or aggregated for more than one account if it is believed it would be consistent with best execution. Aggregation may reduce commission costs or market impact on a per-share and per-dollar basis, although aggregation may have the opposite effect. There may be times when not enough securities are received to fill an aggregated order, including in an initial public offering, involving multiple accounts. In that event, the investment manager and each subadviser has policies and procedures designed in such a way believed to result in a fair allocation among accounts, including the fund.

From time to time, different portfolio managers with the investment manager may make differing investment decisions related to the same security. However, with certain exceptions for funds managed using strictly quantitative methods, a portfolio manager or portfolio management team may not sell a security short if the security is owned in another portfolio managed by that portfolio manager or portfolio management team. On occasion, a fund may purchase and sell a security simultaneously in order to profit from short-term price disparities.

Certain Investment Limitations

From time to time, the investment manager or subadviser for a fund and their respective affiliates (“adviser group”) will be trading in the same securities or be deemed to beneficially hold the same securities. Due to regulatory and other restrictions or limits in various countries or industry- or issuer-specific restrictions or limitations (e.g., poison pills) that restrict the amount of securities or other investments of an issuer that may be held on an aggregate basis by an adviser group, a fund may be limited or prevented from acquiring securities of an issuer that the fund’s adviser may otherwise prefer to purchase. For example, many countries limit the amount of outstanding shares that may be held in a local bank by an adviser group. In these circumstances, a fund may be limited or prevented from purchasing additional shares of a bank if the purchase would put the adviser group over the regulatory limit when the adviser group’s holdings are combined together or with the holdings of the funds’ affiliates, even if the purchases alone on behalf of a specific fund would not be in excess of such limit. Additionally, regulatory and other applicable limits are complex and vary significantly, including, among others, from

 

44


Table of Contents

country to country, industry to industry and issuer to issuer. However, given the complexity of these limits, a fund’s adviser may inadvertently breach these limits, and a fund may be required to sell securities of an issuer in order to be in compliance with such limits even if the fund’s adviser may otherwise prefer to continue to hold such securities. At certain times, the funds may be restricted in their investment activities because of relationships an affiliate of the fund’s, which may include Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates, may have with the issuers of securities.

The investment manager has portfolio management teams in its multiple geographic locations that may share research information regarding leveraged loans. The investment manager operates separate and independent trading desks in these locations for the purpose of purchasing and selling leveraged loans. As a result, the investment manager does not aggregate orders in leveraged loans across portfolio management teams. For example, funds and other client accounts being managed by these portfolio management teams may purchase and sell the same leveraged loan in the secondary market on the same day at different times and at different prices. There is also the potential for a particular account or group of accounts, including a fund, to forego an opportunity or to receive a different allocation (either larger or smaller) than might otherwise be obtained if the investment manager were to aggregate trades in leveraged loans across the portfolio management teams. Although the investment manager does not aggregate orders in leveraged loans across its portfolio management teams in the multiple geographic locations, it operates in this structure subject to its duty to seek best execution.

The following table shows total brokerage commissions paid in the last three fiscal periods. Substantially all firms through whom transactions were executed provide research services. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 4. Total Brokerage Commissions

Total Brokerage Commissions

 

Fund

   2010      2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

       

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   $ 0       $ 0      $ 0 (a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     0         0        0 (a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     0         0        0 (a) 

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     0         0        0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     0         0        0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     0         0        0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     0         0        0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     0         0        0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     0         0        0   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     97,970         16,486        40,706   

RiverSource Small Company Index

        517,354         123,243           108,360   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

       

Columbia Equity Value

     357,285         525,309        591,525   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     288,177         1,067,960        960,159   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

       

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     26,985         38,789        38,557 (b) 

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     527,728         128,097 (c)      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     0         0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     0         0        0   

 

45


Table of Contents

 

Total Brokerage Commissions

 

Fund

   2010      2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

       

Columbia High Yield Bond

   $ 0       $ 0      $ 0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     749,980         1,484,768        1,179,158   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     9,489         14,329        17,640   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     146,283         298,507        292,900   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     21,796         35,642        43,210   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

       

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

     402,958         673,569        412,022   

RiverSource Real Estate

     164,335         205,118        173,705   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

       

Columbia Floating Rate

     0         12,760        861   

Columbia Income Opportunities

     0         0        0   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     43,426         17,762        11,586   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     2,806,058         2,084,675        1,951,255   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     8,523         4,188        4,138   

Columbia Money Market

     0         0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     306,343         541,939        124,754   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     139,213         178,570        75,041   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

       

Columbia Diversified Bond

     121,666         95,997        111,876   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     1,077         0        3,418   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     510         0        1,938   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     174         0        724   
     2009      2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

       

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     649,261         150,374        45,978 (d) 

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     378,324         6,631 (e)      N/A   

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

     4,728,940         4,085,552        3,790,954   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     2,601,029         1,672,775        1,219,474   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     1,248,108         1,049,954        1,425,483   

RiverSource Balanced

     688,814         493,156        567,773   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     22,351         17,707        6,639 (d) 

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

     0         0        0   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

     0         0        0   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

     0         0        0   

Seligman National Municipal

     0         0        0   

Seligman New York Municipal

     0         0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     12,772         7,434        3,559   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     1,327         7,302        2,743   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     1,215         1,206        461   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     1,173         948        308   

Seligman TargETFund Core

     26,992         10,913        10,770   

 

46


Table of Contents

 

Total Brokerage Commissions

 

     2009     2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

      

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

     41,731 (f)      N/A        N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     0        0        0   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     2,108,103        3,346,690        3,361,865   

Columbia European Equity

     189,286        396,474        282,104   

Columbia Frontier

     157,476        250,561        388,531   

Columbia Global Bond

     7,292        18,925        17,268   

Columbia Global Equity

     581,962        1,185,084        1,474,583   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     11,397        6,647 (g)      N/A   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

     959,077        1,558,333        1,426,926   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

     1,319,806        1,747,855        2,082,502   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     500,331        514,960        547,910   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     901,265        1,690,066        1,932,330   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     265,317        270,663        353,096   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

     18,370        5,030 (g)      N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     793,899        1,020,584        1,150,182   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

      

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     315        6,431        19,450   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     2,752,727        2,165,273        2,813,784   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     42        684        2,175   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     1,080        24,531        74,062   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

      

Columbia Government Money Market

     0        0        0   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     12,482,079        11,241,475        17,228,966   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     206,322        236,168        167,912   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     123,904        240,154        217,466   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     20,434        32,671        63,034   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     40,941        82,218        227,752   

Seligman Capital

     927,607        1,815,753        2,088,716   

Seligman Growth

     2,228,705        1,627,919        1,428,056   

 

(a) The fund changed its fiscal year end effective Jan. 31, 2008 from May 31 to Jan. 31. For 2008, the information shown is for the period from June 1, 2007 through Jan. 31, 2008. For years prior to 2008, the fiscal period ended on May 31.
(b) For the period from Oct. 18, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2008.
(c) For the period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares become publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(d) For the period from May 17, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2007.
(e) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(f) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(g) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2008.

 

47


Table of Contents

 

For the last fiscal period, transactions were specifically directed to firms in exchange for research services as shown in the following table. The table also shows portfolio turnover rates for the last two fiscal periods. Higher turnover rates may result in higher brokerage expenses and taxes. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 5. Brokerage Directed for Research and Turnover Rates

 

     Brokerage directed for research*              
           Amount of        
     Amount of     commissions     Turnover rates  

Fund

   transactions     imputed or paid     2010     2009  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

        

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   $ 0 (a)    $ 0 (a)      41     39

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     0 (a)      0 (a)      39        40   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     0 (a)      0 (a)      46        36   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     0 (a)      0 (a)      28        35   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     0 (a)      0 (a)      26        27   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     0 (a)      0 (a)      26        34   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     0 (a)      0 (a)      28        33   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     0 (a)      0 (a)      30        29   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     0 (a)      0 (a)      25        28   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     0        0        41        5   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     0        0        41        23   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

        

Columbia Equity Value

     95,868,655        111,080        30        21   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     42,266,048        35,270        72        340 (b) 

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

        

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     10,891,991        10,904        31        36   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     243,972,941        295,680        11        4 (c) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     0 (a)      0 (a)      53        55   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     0 (a)      0 (a)      126        53   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     0 (a)      0 (a)      53        52   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     0 (a)      0 (a)      52        47   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     0 (a)      0 (a)      57        47   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     0 (a)      0 (a)      54        48   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     0 (a)      0 (a)      55        50   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     0 (a)      0 (a)      64        51   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

        

Columbia High Yield Bond

     0        0        94        83   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     25,296,772        30,410        80        120   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     0        0        519 (d)      431 (d) 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     0        0        9        19   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     0        0        329 (d)      217 (d) 

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

        

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

     66,349,011        55,087        23        21   

RiverSource Real Estate

     6,919,253        9,212        93        51   

 

48


Table of Contents

 

     Brokerage directed for research*              
           Amount of              
     Amount of     commissions     Turnover rates  

Fund

   transactions     imputed or paid     2010     2009  

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

        

Columbia Floating Rate

   $ 0      $ 0        68     84

Columbia Income Opportunities

     0        0        86        81   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     0        0        177 (f)      160 (f) 

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     302,209,602        175,221        75        61   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     0        0        101        335 (d),(g) 

Columbia Money Market

     0        0        N/A        N/A   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     21,380,485        24,466        107        104   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     6,706,217        7,860        114        98   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

        

Columbia Diversified Bond

     0        0        420 (d)      371 (d) 

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     0        0        21        33   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     0        0        19        49   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     0        0        12        34   
                 2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

        

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     115,848,221        85,590        58        70   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     38,146,821        31,490        63        6 (h) 

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

     1,100,570,862        1,494,280        38        31   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     85,198,971        545,756        42        34   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     92,052,055        81,422        136 (d)      123 (d) 

RiverSource Balanced

     134,013,627        160,642        189 (d)      105 (d) 

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     0        0        143        137   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

     0        0        63 (i)      4   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

     0        0        46 (i)      13   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

     0        0        29 (i)      16   

Seligman National Municipal

     0        0        107 (i)      16   

Seligman New York Municipal

     0        0        53 (i)      0   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     0        0        58        70   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     0        0        13        61   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     0        0        16        38   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     0        0        36        48   

Seligman TargETFund Core

     0        0        45        46   

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

        

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

     0        0        16        39   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

     8,232,647 (j)      23,202 (j)      4 (j)      N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     0        0        62        82   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     794,301,729        1,895,074        149        133   

Columbia European Equity

     113,984,459        144,742        154        180   

Columbia Frontier

     142,448,732        47,004        162        156   

Columbia Global Bond

     0        0        69        75   

Columbia Global Equity

     300,110,709        477,223        81        97   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     4,801,721        7,937        133        36 (k) 

 

49


Table of Contents

 

     Brokerage directed for research*               
            Amount of               
     Amount of      commissions      Turnover rates  

Fund

   transactions      imputed or paid      2009     2008  

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   $ 33,502,807       $ 17,102         63     40

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

     2,739,223,355         460,483         150        171   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     8,041,109         2,162         85        61   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     83,531,533         99,348         90        85   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     95,857         63         174        87   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

     6,599,033         11,416         45        10 (k) 

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     536,939,110         737,307         97        78   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

          

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     454,152,183         799,318         126        76   

RiverSource AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     0         0         29        37   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     0         0         26        36   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     0         0         30        37   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

          

Columbia Government Money Market

     N/A         N/A         N/A        N/A   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     69,507,890         68,240         24        28   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     1,444,931         5,200         7        16   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     1,115,825,859         2,102,493         150        133   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     0         0         83        62   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     0         0         87        77   

Seligman Capital

     20,147,615         37,667         139        229   

Seligman Growth

     843,145,024         1,192,083         142        241   

 

* Reported numbers include third party soft dollar commissions and portfolio manager directed commissions directed for research. Columbia Management also receives proprietary research from brokers, but these amounts have not been included in the table.
(a) The underlying funds may have directed transactions to firms in exchange for research services.
(b) Higher turnover rates may result in higher brokerage expenses and taxes. The higher turnover rate can be primarily attributed to repositioning the fund to a smaller number of holdings as it worked through risk management and secondarily, market volatility made up the balance of the turnover rate.
(c) For the period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(d) Includes mortgage dollar rolls. If mortgage dollar roll transactions were excluded, the portfolio turnover would have been: 286% and 199% for RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund and 246% and 162% for Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund for the fiscal periods ended May 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively; 229% and 184% for Columbia Diversified Bond for the fiscal periods ended Aug. 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively; 220% for Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund for the fiscal period ended July 31, 2009; 110% and 86% for RiverSource Balanced Fund and 116% and 89% for Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund for the fiscal periods ended Sept. 30, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
(e) A significant portion of the turnover was the result of “roll” transactions in liquid derivatives and Treasury securities. In the derivative transactions, positions in expiring contracts are liquidated and simultaneously replaced with positions in new contracts with equivalent characteristics. In the Treasury transactions, existing holdings are sold to purchase newly issued securities with slightly longer maturity dates. Although these transactions affect the turnover rate of the portfolio, they do not change the risk exposure or result in material transaction costs. The remaining turnover resulted from strategic reallocations and relative value trading. After transaction costs, this activity is expected to enhance the returns on the fund.
(f) The fund’s turnover rate has historically been low. The increase in turnover rate is primarily a result of repositioning holdings after management changes in the first quarter of 2009 and following a more active management style.
(g) The turnover was a result of a combination of a change in the investment strategy and the growth of the fund. The fund experienced high net inflows in the second quarter of 2009, increasing the NAV.
(h) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(i) The fund’s turnover rate has historically been low. The increase in turnover rate is primarily a result of repositioning holdings after management changes in the second quarter of 2009, and additionally for Seligman National Municipal, mergers of 14 state-specific Seligman Municipal Funds during the period into the Fund.
(j) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when the Fund became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(k) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when the Fund became available) to Oct. 31, 2008.

 

50


Table of Contents

 

As of the end of the most recent fiscal period, the fund held securities of its regular brokers or dealers or of the parent of those brokers or dealers that derived more than 15% of gross revenue from securities-related activities as presented below. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 6. Securities of Regular Brokers or Dealers

 

Fund

  

Issuer

   Value of securities owned at
end of fiscal period
 

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

     

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   None      N/A   

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

   None      N/A   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

   None      N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

   None      N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

   None      N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

   None      N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

   None      N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

   None      N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

   None      N/A   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

   Ameriprise Financial    $ 147,339   
   Charles Schwab      199,837   
   Citigroup      825,442   
   E*Trade Financial      48,192   
   Franklin Resources      216,282   
   Goldman Sachs Group      983,038   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      1,947,078   
   Legg Mason      41,068   
   Morgan Stanley      489,323   
   PNC Financial Services Group      347,103   

RiverSource Small Company Index

   Investment Technology Group      932,730   
   LaBranche & Co.      159,627   
   optionsXpress      645,578   
   Piper Jaffray Companies      677,351   
   Stifel Financial      1,463,301   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

     

Columbia Equity Value

   Goldman Sachs Group      11,067,062   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      13,784,298   
   Morgan Stanley      7,911,083   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

   None      N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

     

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   None      N/A   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

   None      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

   None      N/A   

 

51


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Issuer

   Value of securities owned at
end of fiscal period
 

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

     

Columbia High Yield Bond

   Lehman Brothers Holdings*    $ 1,322,250   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   Raymond James Financial      1,696,199   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

   Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities Trust      339,729   
   Bear Stearns Commercial Mtge Securities      3,164,927   
   ChaseFlex Trust      398,308   
   Citigroup Mortgage Loan Trust, Inc.      1,106,996   
   Credit Suisse Mortgage Capital Ctfs      7,823,287   
   GS Mortgage Securities Corp.      6,427,923   
   Jefferies & Co.      2,284,896   
  

JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mtge Securities

     990,893   
   JPMorgan Mtge Trust      667,343   
   JPMorgan Reremic      534,987   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.      3,039,588   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      2,342,740   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

   Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities Trust      782,912   
   Bear Stearns Commercial Mtge Securities      1,607,987   
   Citigroup Funding      18,414,224   
   Citigroup Mortgage Loan Trust, Inc.      3,441,463   
   Credit Suisse Mortgage Capital Ctfs      7,919,291   
   CS First Boston Mtge Securities      968,402   
   Goldman Sachs Group      7,829,724   
   Jefferies & Co.      1,062,793   
  

JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mtge Securities

     3,998,961   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      2,966,688   
   JPMorgan Mtge Trust      2,196,977   
   Morgan Stanley      8,350,389   
   Morgan Stanley Capital I      4,934,943   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

     

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   Goldman Sachs Group      8,911,501   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      5,407,407   
   Morgan Stanley      10,581,853   

RiverSource Real Estate

   None      N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

     

Columbia Floating Rate

   Nuveen Investments      887,000   

Columbia Income Opportunities

   E*TRADE Financial      4,180,938   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

   Jefferies & Co.      925,026   
   LB-UBS Commercial Mortgage Trust      2,711,440   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

   Citigroup      89,448,117   
   Franklin Resources      10,199,918   
   Goldman Sachs Group      18,407,431   
   PNC Financial Services Group      55,870,310   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

   Citigroup      4,988,135   
   Goldman Sachs Group      5,629,686   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      4,363,771   
   Lehman Brothers Holdings*      95,700   
   Merrill Lynch & Co.      856,523   
   Morgan Stanley      5,284,355   

Columbia Money Market

   Citigroup Funding      100,983,942   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      87,793,771   

 

52


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Issuer

   Value of securities owned at
end of fiscal period
 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

   Investment Technology Group    $ 93,176   
   Jefferies Group, Inc.      76,613   
   Knight Capital Group Cl A      342,359   
   optionsXpress Holdings      113,864   
   Raymond James Financial      1,524,868   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

   Knight Capital Group Cl A      251,175   
   Westwood Holdings Group      104,596   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

     

Columbia Diversified Bond

   Bear Stearns Adjustable Rate Mortgage Trust      5,214,463   
   Bear Stearns Alt-A Trust      22,769   
   Bear Stearns Asset-Backed Securities Trust      3,855,171   
   Bear Stearns Commercial Mortgage Securities      2,278,870   
   Bear Stearns Mortgage Funding Trust      680,868   
   ChaseFlex Trust      1,470,112   
   Citigroup, Inc.      44,244,737   
   Citigroup Commercial Mortgage Trust      3,387,078   
   Citigroup/Deutsche Bank Commercial Mortgage Trust      25,824,909   
   Citigroup Mortgage Loan Trust, Inc.      37,740,867   
   Credit Suisse Mortgage Capital Certificates      59,851,574   
   Credit Suisse First Boston Mortgage Securities Corp.      15,808,795   
   GS Mortgage Securities Corp. II      46,506,875   
   The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.      37,320,156   
   Jefferies & Co., Inc.      6,723,914   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      41,539,862   
   JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mortgage Securities Corp.      104,835,640   
   JPMorgan Mortgage Trust      3,844,284   
   JPMorgan Remeric      4,562,368   
   LB-UBS Commercial Mortgage Trust      35,858,704   
   Lehman Brothers Holdings, Inc.*      2,204,363   
   Merrill Lynch Mortgage Trust      1,656,762   
   Morgan Stanley      36,602,643   
   Morgan Stanley Capital I      16,918,724   
   Morgan Stanley Reremic Trust      50,927,555   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

   None      N/A   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

   None      N/A   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

   None      N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

  

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   Goldman Sachs Group      178,337,738   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      85,834,923   
   Morgan Stanley      52,518,110   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

   Franklin Resources      1,934,035   
   Goldman Sachs Group      20,863,258   
   Morgan Stanley      9,177,567   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

   Citigroup      6,796,957   
   Goldman Sachs Group      6,574,659   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      1,293,917   
   Morgan Stanley      6,536,678   
   PNC Financial Services Group      1,943,649   

 

53


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Issuer

   Value of securities owned at
end of fiscal period
 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

   Goldman Sachs & Co.    $ 47,226,353   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

   Bear Stearns Commercial Mortgage Securities      699,898   
   Citigroup      6,504,737   
   Citigroup Commercial Mortgage Trust      316,302   
   Citigroup/Deutsche Bank Commercial Mortgage Trust      183,715   
   Credit Suisse Group      457,330   
   CS First Boston Mortgage Securities      155,406   
   Goldman Sachs Group      9,642,282   
   GS Mortgage Securities II      788,719   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      10,872,093   
  

JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mortgage Securities

     2,234,879   
   Knight Capital Group Cl A      96,200   
   LB-UBS Commercial Mortgage Trust      559,502   
   Morgan Stanley      9,436,155   
   Morgan Stanley Capital I      709,666   
   optionsXpress Holdings      82,339   
   PNC Financial Services Group      6,225,544   

RiverSource Balanced

   Bear Stearns Adjustable Rate Mortgage Trust      713,060   
   Bear Stearns Commercial Mortgage Securities      899,869   
   ChaseFlex Trust      849,320   
   Citigroup      1,082,219   
   Citigroup Commercial Mortgage Trust      316,302   
  

Citigroup/Deutsche Bank Commercial Mortgage Trust

     393,676   
   Goldman Sachs Group      18,865,931   
   GS Mortgage Securities II      1,030,324   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      8,998,091   
  

JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mortgage Securities

     2,697,566   
   LB-UBS Commercial Mortgage Trust      1,354,451   
   Lehman Brothers Holdings*      236,004   
   Merrill Lynch Mortgage Trust      188,000   
   Morgan Stanley      3,258,404   
   Morgan Stanley Capital I      1,291,191   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

   Ameritrade Holding Corp. — subsidiary      624,828   
   Bear Stearns Commercial Mortgage Securities      868,876   
   Citigroup      118,157   
  

Citigroup/Deutsche Bank Commercial Mortgage Trust

     985,508   
   CS First Boston Mortgage Securities      1,069,849   
   Goldman Sachs Group      171,602   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      268,331   
  

JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mortgage Securities

     889,173   
   Lehman Brothers Holdings*      15,975   
   Merrill Lynch Mortgage Trust      178,336   
   Morgan Stanley      801,038   
   Morgan Stanley Capital I      69,125   
   Nuveen Investments      97,091   

 

54


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Issuer

   Value of securities owned at
end of fiscal period
 

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

   None      N/A   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

   None      N/A   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

   None      N/A   

Seligman National Municipal

   None      N/A   

Seligman New York Municipal

   None      N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

   None      N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

   None      N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

   None      N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

   None      N/A   

Seligman TargETFund Core

   None      N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

     

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   GS Mortgage Securities II    $ 2,719,948   
   Lehman Brothers Holdings*      100,800   
   Morgan Stanley Dean Witter Capital I      428,016   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

   None      N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

   Morgan Stanley      2,351,866   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   None      N/A   

Columbia European Equity

   Credit Suisse Group      2,058,583   

Columbia Frontier

   Affiliated Managers Group      380,940   
   Piper Jaffray Companies      171,643   
   Stifel Financial      244,212   

Columbia Global Bond

  

Bear Stearns Commercial Mortgage Securities

     237,337   
   Citigroup      1,003,392   
   Citigroup Commercial Mortgage Trust      1,581,548   
   CS First Boston Mortgage Securities      595,440   
   Goldman Sachs Group      1,188,323   
   GS Mortgage Securities II      1,102,326   
   JPMorgan Chase Commercial Mortgage Securities      1,702,095   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      770,873   
   LB-UBS Commercial Mortgage Trust      1,501,910   
   Lehman Brothers Holdings*      212,850   
   Merrill Lynch & Co.      366,682   
   Morgan Stanley      11,964,651   
   Morgan Stanley Capital I      1,334,954   

Columbia Global Equity

   Citigroup Commercial Mortgage Trust      6,721,641   
   Credit Suisse Mortgage Capital Certificates      2,352,116   
   Goldman Sachs Group      5,039,414   
   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      9,925,220   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

   Citigroup      64,732   
   Goldman Sachs Group      119,119   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   Citigroup Funding      6,997,755   
   Morgan Stanley      20,000,000   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

   None      N/A   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

   Credit Suisse Mortgage Capital Certificates      3,138,369   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   Credit Suisse Group      4,008,753   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   None      N/A   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   None      N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   Credit Suisse Group      7,751,291   

 

55


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Issuer

   Value of securities owned at
end of fiscal period
 

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

  

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

   None      N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

   E*TRADE Financial    $ 3,797,720   
   Legg Mason      2,696,490   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

   None      N/A   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

   None      N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

  

Columbia Government Money Market

   None      N/A   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

   None      N/A   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

   JPMorgan Chase & Co.      8,334,000   
   Morgan Stanley      7,340,800   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

   None      N/A   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

   None      N/A   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

   None      N/A   

Seligman Capital

   None      N/A   

Seligman Growth

   Goldman Sachs Group      9,455,040   

 

* Subsequent to Aug. 31, 2008. Lehman Brothers Holdings filed a Chapter 11 bankruptcy petition.

 

56


Table of Contents

 

Brokerage Commissions Paid to Brokers Affiliated with the Investment Manager

Affiliates of the investment manager may engage in brokerage and other securities transactions on behalf of a fund according to procedures adopted by the Board and to the extent consistent with applicable provisions of the federal securities laws. Subject to approval by the Board, the same conditions apply to transactions with broker-dealer affiliates of any subadviser. The investment manager will use an affiliate only if (i) the investment manager determines that the fund will receive prices and executions at least as favorable as those offered by qualified independent brokers performing similar brokerage and other services for the fund and (ii) the affiliate charges the fund commission rates consistent with those the affiliate charges comparable unaffiliated customers in similar transactions and if such use is consistent with terms of the Investment Management Services Agreement.

Information about any brokerage commissions paid by a fund in the last three fiscal periods to brokers affiliated with the fund’s investment manager is contained in the following table. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 7. Brokerage Commissions Paid to Investment Manager or Affiliates

 

     Broker      Nature of
affiliation
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Percent of
aggregate
brokerage
commissions
     Percent of
aggregate
dollar
amount of
transactions
involving
payment of
commissions
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
 

Fund

                 2010                    2009      2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

  

           

Columbia Income Builder Fund

     None         —           —           —           —         $ 0       $ 0 (a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0 (a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0 (a) 

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

  

           

Columbia Equity Value

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

 

57


Table of Contents

 

     Broker    Nature of
affiliation
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Percent of
aggregate
brokerage
commissions
     Percent of
aggregate
dollar
amount of
transactions
involving
payment of
commissions
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
    Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
 

Fund

               2010                    2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

  

          

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   None      —           —           —           —         $ 0      $ 0 (b) 

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

   None      —           —           —           —           0 (c)      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

  

       

Columbia High Yield Bond

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

  

          

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Real Estate

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

 

58


Table of Contents

 

     Broker    Nature of
affiliation
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Percent of
aggregate
brokerage
commissions
     Percent of
aggregate
dollar
amount of
transactions
involving
payment of
commissions
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
    Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
 

Fund

               2010                    2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

  

       

Columbia Floating Rate

   None      —           —           —           —         $ 0      $ 0   

Columbia Income Opportunities

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

   None                  0        0   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Money Market

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

              !           

Columbia Diversified Bond

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   
                 2009                    2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

  

    

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0 (d) 

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

   None      —           —           —           —           0 (e)      N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Balanced

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

   None      —           —           —           —           0        0 (d) 

 

59


Table of Contents

 

     Broker   Nature of
affiliation
    Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Percent of
aggregate
brokerage
commissions
    Percent of
aggregate
dollar
amount of
transactions
involving
payment of
commissions
    Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
    Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
 

Fund

             2009                  2008     2007  

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

   None     —          —           —          —        $ 0      $ 0   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman National Municipal

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman New York Municipal

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Seligman TargETFund Core

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

               

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

   None(f)     —          —           —          —          N/A        N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia European Equity

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia Frontier

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia Global Bond

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia Global Equity

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

   None     —          —           —          —          0 (g)      N/A   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   Sanford Bernstein     (1   $ 0         —          —          1,677        0   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   Merrill Lynch
Capital Markets
    (2     585         0.27     0.42     0        0   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   None     —          —           —          —          0 (g)      N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   None     —          —           —          —          0        0   

 

60


Table of Contents

 

     Broker      Nature of
affiliation
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Percent of
aggregate
brokerage
commissions
     Percent of
aggregate
dollar
amount of
transactions
involving
payment of
commissions
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
     Aggregate
dollar
amount of
commissions
paid to
broker
 

Fund

                 2009                    2008      2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

                    

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

                    

Columbia Government Money Market

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Seligman Capital

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

Seligman Growth

     None         —           —           —           —           0         0   

 

(1) Affiliate of AllianceBernstein L.P., a subadviser.
(2) Affiliate of Columbia Wanger Asset Management, L.P., a subadviser.
(a) The fund changed its fiscal year end effective Jan. 31, 2008 from May 31 to Jan. 31. For 2008, the information shown is for the period from June 1, 2007 through Jan. 31, 2008. For years prior to 2008, the fiscal period ended on May 31.
(b) For the period from Oct. 18, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2008.
(c) For the period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(d) For the period from May 17, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2007.
(e) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(f) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(g) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2008.

 

61


Table of Contents

 

Valuing Fund Shares

As of the end of the most recent fiscal period, the computation of net asset value per share of a class of a fund was based on net assets of that class divided by the number of class shares outstanding as shown in the following table. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1. All expenses of a fund, including the management fee and administrative services fee and, as applicable, distribution and plan administration fees, are accrued daily and taken into account for the purpose of determining NAV.

Table 8. Valuing Fund Shares

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

        

Columbia Income Builder Fund

        

Class A

   $ 191,609,144         19,630,870       $ 9.76   

Class B

     24,940,436         2,547,850         9.79   

Class C

     12,407,352         1,267,551         9.79   

Class R4

     9,771         1,000         9.77   

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

        

Class A

     336,673,414         35,567,971         9.47   

Class B

     35,116,660         3,701,134         9.49   

Class C

     15,534,369         1,636,863         9.49   

Class R4

     18,248         1,926         9.47   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

        

Class A

     169,340,312         17,933,995         9.44   

Class B

     17,093,815         1,803,903         9.48   

Class C

     8,762,187         925,152         9.47   

Class R4

     36,268         3,844         9.43   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

        

Class A

     411,905,718         47,812,554         8.62   

Class B

     69,631,727         8,121,597         8.57   

Class C

     26,852,423         3,157,443         8.50   

Class R4

     391,084         45,318         8.63   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

        

Class A

     188,324,159         19,284,494         9.77   

Class B

     38,996,195         4,007,171         9.73   

Class C

     18,361,827         1,886,873         9.73   

Class R4

     68,268         7,043         9.69   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

        

Class A

     936,670,111         99,022,922         9.46   

Class B

     163,374,895         17,355,229         9.41   

Class C

     60,532,854         6,431,212         9.41   

Class R4

     221,015         23,381         9.45   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

        

Class A

     848,711,038         93,990,508         9.03   

Class B

     143,830,084         16,003,632         8.99   

Class C

     44,907,699         5,004,198         8.97   

Class R4

     842,067         93,149         9.04   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

        

Class A

     335,708,725         34,921,226         9.61   

Class B

     60,124,214         6,274,529         9.58   

Class C

     26,207,827         2,735,790         9.58   

Class R4

     28,861         3,017         9.57   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

        

Class A

     348,269,405         42,472,580         8.20   

Class B

     56,041,391         6,869,051         8.16   

Class C

     25,712,743         3,180,656         8.08   

Class R4

     227,529         27,657         8.23   

 

62


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

        

Class A**

   $ 21,534,109         6,062,565       $ 3.55   

Class Z**

     100,496,276         28,199,115         3.56   

RiverSource Small Company Index

        

Class A

     328,913,706         84,403,946         3.90   

Class B

     43,947,939         14,032,865         3.13   

Class R4

     6,632,993         1,640,892         4.04   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

        

Columbia Equity Value

        

Class A

     681,073,286         70,741,844         9.63   

Class B

     50,132,060         5,184,913         9.67   

Class C

     4,895,038         512,462         9.55   

Class I

     18,363,036         1,905,271         9.64   

Class R

     30,124         3,129         9.63   

Class R3

     183,254         19,014         9.64   

Class R4

     10,092,743         1,046,026         9.65   

Class R5

     6,508         676         9.63   

Class W

     3,658         380         9.63   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

        

Class A

     133,459,266         10,925,790         12.22   

Class B

     13,809,631         1,240,361         11.13   

Class C

     4,233,101         389,141         10.88   

Class I

     12,268         989         12.40   

Class R4

     177,328         14,319         12.38   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

        

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

        

Class A

     33,365,848         2,185,314         15.27   

Class B

     1,401,883         92,764         15.11   

Class C

     2,405,895         159,728         15.06   

Class I

     4,324,899         281,691         15.35   

Class R5

     7,670         500         15.34   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

        

Class A

     438,673,229         22,317,277         19.66   

Class B

     21,596,850         1,108,701         19.48   

Class C

     27,986,758         1,436,501         19.48   

Class I

     117,332,774         5,939,737         19.75   

Class R

     80,728         4,127         19.56   

Class R3

     19,621         1,000         19.62   

Class R4

     623,844         31,702         19.68   

Class R5

     59,600         3,020         19.74   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

        

Class A

     3,004,756         352,192         8.53   

Class R

     3,994         468         8.53   

Class R3

     3,994         468         8.53   

Class R4

     3,996         468         8.54   

Class R5

     3,998         468         8.54   

Class Y

     5,248,330         614,374         8.54   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

        

Class A

     5,097,950         597,650         8.53   

Class R

     3,973         465         8.54   

Class R3

     3,973         465         8.54   

Class R4

     3,975         465         8.55   

Class R5

     3,981         465         8.56   

Class Y

     16,572,401         1,937,035         8.56   

 

63


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

        

Class A

   $ 5,667,643         702,748       $ 8.06   

Class R

     78,158         9,696         8.06   

Class R3

     3,759         464         8.10   

Class R4

     3,760         464         8.10   

Class R5

     3,765         464         8.11   

Class Y

     17,797,248         2,195,426         8.11   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

        

Class A

     3,282,520         407,390         8.06   

Class R

     22,706         2,823         8.04   

Class R3

     3,768         466         8.09   

Class R4

     3,778         465         8.12   

Class R5

     3,778         465         8.12   

Class Y

     23,159,563         2,856,811         8.11   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

        

Class A

     3,128,008         387,287         8.08   

Class R

     11,770         1,457         8.08   

Class R3

     3,744         464         8.07   

Class R4

     3,752         464         8.09   

Class R5

     3,757         464         8.10   

Class Y

     22,379,892         2,763,842         8.10   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

        

Class A

     1,956,294         244,856         7.99   

Class R

     3,735         467         8.00   

Class R3

     3,739         467         8.01   

Class R4

     3,740         467         8.01   

Class R5

     3,746         467         8.02   

Class Y

     17,305,186         2,157,431         8.02   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

        

Class A

     1,741,154         224,227         7.77   

Class R

     11,120         1,430         7.78   

Class R3

     35,194         4,525         7.78   

Class R4

     3,616         464         7.79   

Class R5

     3,621         464         7.80   

Class Y

     12,213,457         1,565,039         7.80   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

        

Class A

     1,471,608         185,478         7.93   

Class R

     4,460         562         7.94   

Class R3

     3,702         466         7.94   

Class R4

     13,137         1,653         7.95   

Class R5

     3,708         466         7.96   

Class Y

     11,614,891         1,459,211         7.96   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

        

Columbia High Yield Bond

        

Class A

     1,192,635,686         457,046,893         2.61   

Class B

     91,104,344         34,942,309         2.61   

Class C

     70,488,596         27,193,543         2.59   

Class I

     144,202,631         55,371,206         2.60   

Class R

     5,689,581         2,174,204         2.62   

Class R3

     4,003,157         1,526,132         2.62   

Class R4

     43,405,874         16,621,906         2.61   

Class R5

     7,957,720         3,054,300         2.61   

Class W

     100,226,537         38,706,595         2.59   

 

64


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

        

Class A

   $ 277,383,581         56,445,589       $ 4.91   

Class B

     62,403,783         13,736,068         4.54   

Class C

     7,765,256         1,704,900         4.55   

Class I

     43,814,661         8,585,111         5.10   

Class R

     679,273         138,536         4.90   

Class R3

     439,854         88,320         4.98   

Class R4

     370,250         73,789         5.02   

Class R5

     11,078,515         2,197,207         5.04   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

        

Class A

     80,371,258         15,588,925         5.16   

Class B

     17,619,412         3,416,007         5.16   

Class C

     5,217,051         1,011,314         5.16   

Class I

     132,494,594         25,723,583         5.15   

Class R4

     85,125         16,536         5.15   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

        

Class A

     307,057,850         70,426,307         4.36   

Class B

     51,870,545         12,425,795         4.17   

Class C

     8,227,996         1,965,058         4.19   

Class I

     174,554,927         39,571,435         4.41   

Class R4

     153,322         34,916         4.39   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

        

Class A

     488,090,547         102,802,359         4.75   

Class B

     66,777,148         14,065,529         4.75   

Class C

     27,832,188         5,862,287         4.75   

Class I

     67,563,272         14,218,020         4.75   

Class R

     2,999,953         631,892         4.75   

Class R4

     4,709,513         991,519         4.75   

Class W

     4,996         1,053         4.74   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

        

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

        

Class A

     883,208,464         139,966,191         6.31   

Class B

     68,144,709         10,871,463         6.27   

Class C

     21,354,419         3,418,234         6.25   

Class I

     165,701,325         26,198,041         6.32   

Class R

     196,428         31,069         6.32   

Class R3

     4,127         653         6.32   

Class R4

     1,455,755         230,050         6.33   

Class R5

     968,152         152,954         6.33   

Class W

     3,592         568         6.32   

RiverSource Real Estate

        

Class A

     52,648,116         5,701,458         9.23   

Class B

     6,533,282         713,272         9.16   

Class C

     1,396,367         152,727         9.14   

Class I

     131,165,236         14,173,209         9.25   

Class R4

     60,555         6,587         9.19   

Class W

     2,528         275         9.19   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

        

Columbia Floating Rate

        

Class A

     226,172,173         26,483,112         8.54   

Class B

     9,928,119         1,161,939         8.54   

Class C

     21,210,203         2,483,252         8.54   

Class I

     101,982,065         11,945,601         8.54   

Class R4

     178,181         20,812         8.56   

Class R5

     4,760         556         8.56   

Class W

     4,246         497         8.54   

 

65


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Columbia Income Opportunities

        

Class A

   $ 498,802,615         51,300,169       $ 9.72   

Class B

     29,050,926         2,989,075         9.72   

Class C

     60,481,511         6,224,222         9.72   

Class I

     182,941,408         18,794,063         9.73   

Class R4

     403,599         41,375         9.75   

Class R5

     5,068         521         9.73   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

        

Class A

     297,826,817         28,749,837         10.36   

Class B

     14,961,461         1,445,877         10.35   

Class C

     17,160,807         1,658,844         10.35   

Class I

     184,100,334         17,768,869         10.36   

Class R

     1,474,003         142,411         10.35   

Class R4

     79,085         7,639         10.35   

Class R5

     5,139         496         10.36   

Class W

     100,345,459         9,690,622         10.35   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

        

Class A

     2,688,843,397         567,423,999         4.74   

Class B

     153,325,657         32,554,969         4.71   

Class C

     21,982,264         4,714,140         4.66   

Class I

     314,250,741         65,856,337         4.77   

Class R

     2,193,578         463,276         4.73   

Class R3

     6,033         1,273         4.74   

Class R4

     162,518,882         34,154,804         4.76   

Class R5

     24,848,139         5,229,982         4.75   

Class W

     373,927,157         79,042,111         4.73   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

        

Class A

     392,689,453         39,500,738         9.94   

Class B

     11,562,307         1,163,439         9.94   

Class C

     49,324,257         4,964,675         9.94   

Class I

     126,851,810         12,755,538         9.94   

Class R4

     540,555         54,240         9.97   

Class W

     5,096         512         9.95   

Columbia Money Market

        

Class A

     2,528,588,079         2,528,587,497         1.00   

Class B

     33,926,741         33,926,744         1.00   

Class C

     7,909,529         7,909,540         1.00   

Class I

     27,174,833         27,174,915         1.00   

Class R

     2,500         2,500         1.00   

Class R5

     725,626         725,628         1.00   

Class W

     34,576,967         34,577,375         1.00   

Class Y

     26,190,282         26,190,329         1.00   

Class Z

     19,816,215         19,816,218         1.00   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

        

Class A

     9,570,996         1,291,322         7.41   

Class B

     586,284         81,313         7.21   

Class C

     205,141         28,435         7.21   

Class I

     27,121,153         3,643,387         7.44   

Class R4

     8,952         1,206         7.42   

Class W

     104,872,014         14,205,922         7.38   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

        

Class A

     3,483,311         441,264         7.89   

Class B

     141,730         18,276         7.75   

Class C

     120,243         15,510         7.75   

Class I

     47,679,790         6,023,250         7.92   

Class R

     3,587         455         7.88   

Class R3

     5,300         672         7.89   

Class R4

     7,899         1,000         7.90   

Class R5

     3,599         455         7.91   

 

66


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

        

Columbia Diversified Bond

        

Class A

   $ 3,258,076,487         642,678,449       $ 5.07   

Class B

     116,363,532         22,963,835         5.07   

Class C

     61,700,918         12,168,343         5.07   

Class I

     1,021,032,051         201,137,653         5.08   

Class R2

     1,040,372         204,835         5.08   

Class R3

     11,200         2,207         5.07   

Class R4

     74,983,846         14,807,342         5.06   

Class R5

     237,004         46,821         5.06   

Class W

     525,188,670         103,547,472         5.07   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

        

Class A

     329,334,780         60,200,883         5.47   

Class B

     5,767,557         1,053,321         5.48   

Class C

     20,225,454         3,696,926         5.47   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

        

Class A

     150,279,608         29,127,363         5.16   

Class B

     1,787,095         346,584         5.16   

Class C

     3,499,880         677,462         5.17   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

        

Class A

     52,428,136         10,220,753         5.13   

Class B

     1,330,181         259,423         5.13   

Class C

     1,038,696         202,525         5.13   

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

        

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

        

Class A

     3,516,947,647         423,238,665         8.31   

Class B

     377,652,270         45,345,973         8.33   

Class C

     72,371,930         8,719,127         8.30   

Class I

     212,064,386         25,537,767         8.30   

Class R

     8,271,071         998,943         8.28   

Class R3

     110,247,680         13,285,646         8.30   

Class R4

     197,976,509         23,806,751         8.32   

Class R5

     53,334,196         6,415,412         8.31   

Class W

     3,002         361         8.32   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

        

Class A

     274,023,730         36,524,683         7.50   

Class B

     3,579,138         481,472         7.43   

Class C

     1,561,360         210,004         7.43   

Class I

     206,056,085         27,238,022         7.57   

Class R

     7,533         1,000         7.53   

Class R3

     7,539         1,000         7.54   

Class R4

     7,730         1,025         7.54   

Class R5

     7,561         1,000         7.56   

Class W

     188,126,122         25,003,227         7.52   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

        

Class A

     1,434,098         184,422         7.78   

Class B

     57,553         7,464         7.71   

Class C

     27,275         3,524         7.74   

Class I

     60,019,450         7,688,355         7.81   

Class R

     7,766         1,000         7.77   

Class R3

     7,779         1,000         7.78   

Class R4

     13,843         1,776         7.79   

Class R5

     7,804         1,000         7.80   

Class W

     237,104,669         30,469,778         7.78   

 

67


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

        

Class A

   $ 1,351,336,081         219,846,167       $ 6.15   

Class B

     104,322,229         17,668,539         5.90   

Class C

     41,952,034         7,101,337         5.91   

Class I

     44,213,966         7,069,592         6.25   

Class R

     15,826,707         2,592,379         6.11   

Class R3

     46,598,913         7,595,392         6.14   

Class R4

     337,592,770         54,533,230         6.19   

Class R5

     133,143,010         21,466,665         6.20   

Class W

     3,138         506         6.20   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

        

Class A

     1,122,673,319         133,009,047         8.44   

Class B

     115,318,212         13,795,868         8.36   

Class C

     46,514,897         5,592,862         8.32   

Class I

     3,660         434         8.43   

Class R

     3,660         434         8.43   

Class R3

     3,660         434         8.43   

Class R4

     1,219,103         144,213         8.45   

Class R5

     3,660         434         8.43   

RiverSource Balanced

        

Class A

     567,386,530         64,566,373         8.79   

Class B

     17,661,853         2,021,254         8.74   

Class C

     9,454,482         1,084,116         8.72   

Class R

     119,765         13,638         8.78   

Class R4

     45,391,810         5,164,844         8.79   

Class R5

     10,692         1,217         8.79   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

        

Class A

     255,190,331         26,582,876         9.60   

Class B

     25,702,531         2,676,844         9.60   

Class C

     13,328,854         1,389,310         9.59   

Class R

     5,157         537         9.60   

Class R3

     5,157         537         9.60   

Class R4

     68,365         7,124         9.60   

Class R5

     5,157         537         9.60   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

        

Class A

     31,142,713         4,653,633         6.69   

Class C

     6,162,106         919,720         6.70   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

        

Class A

     40,319,393         6,023,523         6.69   

Class C

     3,514,624         527,353         6.66   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

        

Class A

     71,247,393         9,145,572         7.79   

Class C

     1,407,064         180,200         7.81   

Seligman National Municipal

        

Class A

     665,767,573         82,031,969         8.12   

Class C

     36,644,916         4,493,860         8.15   

Seligman New York Municipal

        

Class A

     76,943,770         9,243,243         8.32   

Class C

     8,196,244         982,659         8.34   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

        

Class A

     12,869,269         1,940,646         6.63   

Class C

     12,264,632         1,882,061         6.52   

Class R

     1,495,666         226,740         6.60   

Class R5

     25,221         3,765         6.70   

 

68


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Seligman TargETFund 2025

        

Class A

   $ 17,518,203         2,562,329       $ 6.84   

Class C

     13,402,662         2,002,910         6.69   

Class R

     3,182,793         469,091         6.79   

Class R5

     245,363         35,571         6.90   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

        

Class A

     5,955,957         840,606         7.09   

Class C

     2,414,707         346,244         6.97   

Class R

     1,481,321         209,743         7.06   

Class R5

     7,946         1,115         7.13   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

        

Class A

     3,216,301         455,251         7.06   

Class C

     882,294         126,804         6.96   

Class R

     523,492         74,309         7.04   

Class R5

     17,878         2,516         7.11   

Seligman TargETFund Core

        

Class A

     20,084,624         3,119,620         6.44   

Class C

     28,956,029         4,495,509         6.44   

Class R

     9,547,700         1,483,888         6.43   

Class R5

     105,101         16,332         6.44   

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

        

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

        

Class A

     114,237,775         11,504,415         9.93   

Class B

     2,026,053         205,708         9.85   

Class C

     7,609,307         773,530         9.84   

Class I

     28,925,560         2,899,043         9.98   

Class R4

     9,944         1,000         9.94   

Class R5

     9,397         942         9.98   

Class W

     86,999,758         8,768,011         9.92   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

        

Class R5

     53,643,171         4,698,479         11.42   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

        

Class A

     32,726,471         3,161,305         10.35   

Class B

     2,419,853         234,037         10.34   

Class C

     722,068         69,939         10.32   

Class I

     106,358,547         10,273,954         10.35   

Class R4

     23,156         2,238         10.35   

Class W

     117,037,431         11,319,382         10.34   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

        

Class A

     416,296,725         53,776,169         7.74   

Class B

     38,489,191         5,601,155         6.87   

Class C

     32,757,231         4,756,330         6.89   

Class I

     68,977,761         8,575,621         8.04   

Class R

     12,235,711         1,580,451         7.74   

Class R4

     1,186,515         147,397         8.05   

Class R5

     538,197         66,743         8.06   

Columbia European Equity

        

Class A

     64,717,075         13,311,370         4.86   

Class B

     6,123,682         1,268,930         4.83   

Class C

     1,156,669         240,707         4.81   

Class I

     6,487         1,336         4.86   

Class R4

     18,019         3,711         4.86   

 

69


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Columbia Frontier

        

Class A

   $ 23,379,805         2,848,890       $ 8.21   

Class B

     1,118,495         169,585         6.60   

Class C

     8,899,070         1,342,806         6.63   

Class I

     999,800         114,806         8.71   

Class R

     81,518         10,109         8.06   

Class R3

     5,027         623         8.07   

Class R4

     9,819         1,128         8.70   

Class R5

     625,564         71,840         8.71   

Columbia Global Bond

        

Class A

     252,772,959         35,605,039         7.10   

Class B

     29,976,819         4,198,213         7.14   

Class C

     5,556,941         784,634         7.08   

Class I

     169,716,515         23,886,385         7.11   

Class R4

     168,713         23,740         7.11   

Class W

     60,278,436         8,500,017         7.09   

Columbia Global Equity

        

Class A

     394,510,625         64,353,725         6.13   

Class B

     33,008,877         5,717,899         5.77   

Class C

     10,570,042         1,851,492         5.71   

Class I

     32,596,470         5,289,556         6.16   

Class R

     46,070         7,498         6.14   

Class R3

     3,897         634         6.15   

Class R4

     6,058,555         980,165         6.18   

Class R5

     17,622         2,861         6.16   

Class W

     3,934         639         6.16   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

        

Class A

     2,647,582         150,018         17.65   

Class B

     258,403         14,788         17.47   

Class C

     125,035         7,154         17.48   

Class I

     4,366,888         246,500         17.72   

Class R

     8,780         500         17.56   

Class R3

     8,808         500         17.62   

Class R4

     59,122         3,345         17.67   

Class R5

     8,852         500         17.70   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

        

Class A

     710,323,385         125,309,364         5.67   

Class B

     80,458,495         15,117,302         5.32   

Class C

     10,917,260         2,057,531         5.31   

Class I

     182,888,529         31,357,443         5.83   

Class R4

     493,430         85,118         5.80   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

        

Class A

     325,789,863         19,750,519         16.50   

Class B

     21,966,464         1,541,875         14.25   

Class C

     69,848,512         4,900,053         14.25   

Class I

     23,827,145         1,442,107         16.52   

Class R

     5,131,007         315,762         16.25   

Class R3

     5,301         326         16.26   

Class R4

     289,226         17,518         16.51   

Class R5

     5,304         321         16.52   

 

70


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

        

Class A

   $ 49,044,997         7,030,588       $ 6.98   

Class B

     7,031,214         1,021,394         6.88   

Class C

     1,094,910         159,170         6.88   

Class I

     126,948,273         18,085,070         7.02   

Class R

     3,525         509         6.93   

Class R3

     3,530         509         6.94   

Class R4

     69,728         9,972         6.99   

Class R5

     3,546         509         6.97   

Class W

     282,912,809         40,530,503         6.98   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

        

Class A

     181,148,068         31,216,716         5.80   

Class B

     24,733,743         4,433,114         5.58   

Class C

     9,527,501         1,710,456         5.57   

Class I

     191,323,369         32,651,792         5.86   

Class R

     122,389         21,139         5.79   

Class R4

     489,252         84,049         5.82   

Class R5

     938,080         159,892         5.87   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

        

Class A

     25,159,619         4,951,093         5.08   

Class B

     4,125,636         846,784         4.87   

Class C

     486,947         100,059         4.87   

Class I

     31,466,684         6,079,010         5.18   

Class R4

     401,664         78,176         5.14   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

        

Class A

     21,078,520         2,483,415         8.49   

Class B

     2,067,434         244,105         8.47   

Class C

     449,282         53,062         8.47   

Class I

     4,190,596         493,000         8.50   

Class R

     8,493         1,000         8.49   

Class R3

     8,495         1,000         8.50   

Class R4

     10,456         1,230         8.50   

Class R5

     8,499         1,000         8.50   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

        

Class A

     257,909,909         33,503,026         7.70   

Class B

     20,431,810         2,710,581         7.54   

Class C

     6,942,369         936,735         7.41   

Class I

     116,826,749         15,026,177         7.77   

Class R

     1,110,150         142,157         7.81   

Class R3

     3,876         496         7.81   

Class R4

     226,706         28,868         7.85   

Class R5

     3,890         496         7.84   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

        

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

        

Class A

     645,167,080         173,557,831         3.72   

Class B

     14,670,642         3,944,081         3.72   

Class C

     8,445,704         2,271,237         3.72   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

        

Class A

     553,923,464         64,580,896         8.58   

Class B

     50,253,513         7,048,364         7.13   

Class C

     7,874,750         1,103,661         7.14   

Class I

     71,139,006         7,877,330         9.03   

Class R4

     4,055,434         458,745         8.84   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

        

Class A

     84,077,384         15,978,559         5.26   

Class B

     3,518,592         669,458         5.26   

Class C

     4,753,140         904,158         5.26   

 

71


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

        

Class A

   $ 2,233,824,301         533,202,685       $ 4.19   

Class B

     37,295,962         8,910,422         4.19   

Class C

     15,135,314         3,611,273         4.19   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

        

Columbia Government Money Market

        

Class A

     89,878,036         89,888,902         1.00   

Class B

     4,745,466         4,744,006         1.00   

Class C

     13,538,936         13,518,927         1.00   

Class R

     3,134,050         3,134,336         1.00   

Class R5

     128,883         128,873         1.00   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

        

Class A

     202,826,281         16,478,708         12.31   

Class B

     5,889,617         506,900         11.62   

Class C

     40,629,661         3,493,324         11.63   

Class I

     23,869,523         1,894,164         12.60   

Class R

     8,288,348         679,748         12.19   

Class R3

     5,402         443         12.19   

Class R4

     5,412         430         12.59   

Class R5

     718,316         56,928         12.62   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

        

Class A

     221,181,372         17,565,526         12.59   

Class B

     26,499,678         2,376,033         11.15   

Class C

     46,625,791         4,175,990         11.17   

Class I

     6,299,696         471,820         13.35   

Class R

     10,777,562         872,458         12.35   

Class R3

     5,568         450         12.37   

Class R4

     41,632         3,122         13.34   

Class R5

     1,807,541         135,374         13.35   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

        

Class A

     2,788,834,356         71,908,305         38.78   

Class B

     106,645,895         3,289,023         32.42   

Class C

     694,889,021         21,418,226         32.44   

Class I

     39,507,415         980,688         40.29   

Class R

     37,012,489         971,801         38.09   

Class R3

     16,436         431         38.13   

Class R4

     7,565         188         40.24   

Class R5

     14,853,268         368,766         40.28   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

        

Class A

     3,954,525         1,131,585         3.49   

Class C

     3,230,557         928,401         3.48   

Class I

     5,868,744         1,675,386         3.50   

Class R

     65,688         18,792         3.50   

Class R3

     5,971         1,706         3.50   

Class R4

     7,004         2,001         3.50   

Class R5

     1,356,462         387,086         3.50   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

        

Class A

     6,537,789         1,804,866         3.62   

Class B

     2,419,442         668,153         3.62   

Class C

     10,283,911         2,841,350         3.62   

Class I

     1,709,431         471,537         3.63   

Class R

     3,927,576         1,088,654         3.61   

Class R3

     6,521         1,805         3.61   

Class R4

     16,991         4,682         3.63   

Class R5

     1,357,398         375,009         3.62   

 

72


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

   Net assets      Shares
outstanding
     Net asset value
of one Share
 

Seligman Capital

        

Class A

   $ 157,108,911         7,820,630       $ 20.09   

Class B

     5,955,476         365,780         16.28   

Class C

     45,861,279         2,809,562         16.32   

Class I

     12,192,369         581,385         20.97   

Class R

     10,324,166         520,475         19.84   

Class R3

     5,618         283         19.85   

Class R4

     5,632         269         20.94   

Class R5

     1,754,570         83,689         20.97   

Seligman Growth

        

Class A

     1,243,927,994         305,941,924         4.07   

Class B

     97,446,493         30,519,910         3.19   

Class C

     32,821,061         10,276,754         3.19   

Class I

     238,196,380         56,595,677         4.21   

Class R

     1,088,235         272,087         4.00   

Class R3

     6,400         1,597         4.01   

Class R4

     31,688,383         7,529,168         4.21   

Class R5

     420,125         99,877         4.21   

 

* Effective Sept. 7, 2010, Class R2 was renamed as Class R.
** Effective Sept. 7, 2010, Class D was renamed as Class A and Class E was renamed as Class Z.

For Funds other than Money Market Funds. A fund’s securities are valued as follows as of the close of business of the New York Stock Exchange (the Exchange):

 

   

Securities traded on a securities exchange for which a last-quoted sales price is readily available are valued at the last-quoted sales price on the exchange where such security is primarily traded.

 

   

Securities traded on a securities exchange for which a last-quoted sales price is not readily available are valued at the mean of the closing bid and asked prices, looking first to the bid and asked prices on the exchange where the security is primarily traded and, if none exist, to the over-the-counter market.

 

   

Securities included in the NASDAQ National Market System are valued at the last-quoted sales price in this market.

 

   

Securities included in the NASDAQ National Market System for which a last-quoted sales price is not readily available, and other securities traded over-the-counter but not included in the NASDAQ National Market System are valued at the mean of the closing bid and asked prices.

 

   

Futures and options traded on major exchanges are valued at the last-quoted sales price on their primary exchange.

 

   

Foreign securities traded outside the United States are generally valued as of the time their trading is complete, which is usually different from the close of the Exchange. Foreign securities quoted in foreign currencies are translated into U.S. dollars utilizing spot exchange rates at the close of regular trading on the Exchange.

 

   

Occasionally, events affecting the value of securities occur between the time the primary market on which the securities are traded closes and the close of the Exchange. If events materially affect the value of securities, the securities will be valued at their fair value according to procedures decided upon in good faith by the Board. This occurs most commonly with foreign securities, but may occur in other cases. The fair value of a security is likely to be different from the quoted or published price.

 

   

Short-term securities maturing more than 60 days from the valuation date are valued at the readily available market price or approximate market value based on current interest rates. Typically, short-term securities maturing in 60 days or less that originally had maturities of more than 60 days at acquisition date are valued at amortized cost using the market value on the 61st day before maturity. Short-term securities maturing in 60 days or less at acquisition date are valued at amortized cost. Amortized cost is an approximation of market value determined by systematically increasing the carrying value of a security if acquired at a discount, or reducing the carrying value if acquired at a premium, so that the carrying value is equal to maturity value on the maturity date.

 

   

Securities without a readily available market price and securities for which the price quotations or valuations received from other sources are deemed unreliable or not reflective of market value are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by the Board. The Board is responsible for selecting methods it believes provide fair value.

 

73


Table of Contents

 

   

When possible, bonds are valued at an evaluated bid by a pricing service independent from the funds. If a valuation of a bond is not available from a pricing service, the bond will be valued by a dealer knowledgeable about the bond if such a dealer is available.

The assets of funds-of-funds consist primarily of shares of the underlying funds, which are valued at their NAVs. Other securities held by funds-of-funds are valued as described above.

For Money Market Funds. In accordance with Rule 2a-7 of the 1940 Act, all of the securities in the fund’s portfolio are valued at amortized cost. The amortized cost method of valuation is an approximation of market value determined by systematically increasing the carrying value of a security if acquired at a discount, or reducing the carrying value if acquired at a premium, so that the carrying value is equal to maturity value on the maturity date. Amortized cost does not take into consideration unrealized capital gains or losses.

The Board has established procedures designed to stabilize the fund’s price per share for purposes of sales and redemptions at $1, to the extent that it is reasonably possible to do so. These procedures include review of the fund’s securities by the Board, at intervals deemed appropriate by it, to determine whether the fund’s net asset value per share computed by using available market quotations deviates from a share value of $1 as computed using the amortized cost method. The Board must consider any deviation that appears and, if it exceeds 0.5%, it must determine what action, if any, needs to be taken. If the Board determines a deviation exists that may result in a material dilution of the holdings of current shareholders or investors, or in any other unfair consequences for shareholders, it must undertake remedial action that it deems necessary and appropriate. Such action may include withholding dividends, calculating net asset value per share for purposes of sales and redemptions using available market quotations, making redemptions in kind, and selling securities before maturity in order to realize capital gains or losses or to shorten average portfolio maturity.

While the amortized cost method provides certainty and consistency in portfolio valuation, it may result in valuations of securities that are either somewhat higher or lower than the prices at which the securities could be sold. This means that during times of declining interest rates the yield on the fund’s shares may be higher than if valuations of securities were made based on actual market prices and estimates of market prices. Accordingly, if using the amortized cost method were to result in a lower portfolio value, a prospective investor in the fund would be able to obtain a somewhat higher yield than the investor would get if portfolio valuations were based on actual market values. Existing shareholders, on the other hand, would receive a somewhat lower yield than they would otherwise receive. The opposite would happen during a period of rising interest rates.

Portfolio Holdings Disclosure

Each fund’s Board and the investment manager believe that the investment ideas of the investment manager and any subadviser with respect to portfolio management of a fund should benefit the fund and its shareholders, and do not want to afford speculators an opportunity to profit by anticipating fund trading strategies or by using fund portfolio holdings information for stock picking. However, each fund’s Board also believes that knowledge of the fund’s portfolio holdings can assist shareholders in monitoring their investments, making asset allocation decisions, and evaluating portfolio management techniques.

Each fund’s Board has therefore adopted policies and procedures relating to disclosure of the fund’s portfolio securities. These policies and procedures are intended to protect the confidentiality of fund portfolio holdings information and generally prohibit the release of such information until such information is made public, unless such persons have been authorized to receive such information on a selective basis, as described below. It is the policy of the fund not to provide or permit others to provide portfolio holdings on a selective basis, and the investment manager does not intend to selectively disclose portfolio holdings or expect that such holdings information will be selectively disclosed, except where necessary for the fund’s operation or where there are legitimate business purposes for doing so and, in any case, where conditions are met that are designed to protect the interests of the fund and its shareholders.

Although the investment manager seeks to limit the selective disclosure of portfolio holdings information and such selective disclosure is monitored under the fund’s compliance program for conformity with the policies and procedures, there can be no assurance that these policies will protect the fund from the potential misuse of holdings information by individuals or firms in possession of that information. Under no circumstances may the investment manager, its affiliates or any employee thereof receive any consideration or compensation for disclosing such holdings information.

Public Disclosures

The funds’ portfolio holdings are currently disclosed to the public through filings with the SEC and postings on the funds’ website. The information is available on the funds’ website as described below.

 

74


Table of Contents

 

   

For Equity and Balanced funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of month-end are posted on the website on a monthly basis approximately, but no earlier than, 15 calendar days after each month-end. The four most recent consecutive monthly disclosures remain posted for each fund. Such portfolio holdings information posted on the website includes the name of each portfolio security, number of shares held by the fund, value of the security and the security’s percentage of the market value of the fund’s portfolio as of month-end.

 

   

For Fixed Income funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of calendar quarter-end are posted on the website on a quarterly basis approximately, but no earlier than, 30 calendar days after such quarter-end, and remain posted at least until the date on which the fund files its Form N-CSR or Form N-Q with the SEC for the subsequent fiscal period. Fixed income fund portfolio holdings information posted on the website shall include the name of each portfolio security, maturity/rate, par value and the security’s percentage of the market value of the fund’s portfolio as of calendar quarter-end.

 

   

For Money Market funds, a complete list of fund portfolio holdings as of month-end are posted on the website on a monthly basis, approximately five business days after such month-end. Commencing with the month-end holdings as of September 2010 and thereafter, such month-end holdings will be continuously available on the website for at least six months, together with a link to an SEC webpage where a user of the website may obtain access to the fund’s most recent 12 months of publicly available filings on Form N-MFP. Additionally, as of September 2010 and thereafter, Money Market fund portfolio holdings information posted on the website will, at minimum, include with respect to each holding, the name of the issuer, the category of investment (e.g., Treasury debt, government agency debt, asset backed commercial paper, structured investment vehicle note), the CUSIP number (if any), the principal amount, the maturity date (as determined under Rule 2a-7 for purposes of calculating weighted average maturity), the final maturity date (if different from the maturity date previously described), coupon or yield and the amortized cost value. The Money Market funds will also disclose on the website the overall weighted average maturity and weighted average life maturity of a holding and any other information that may be required by the SEC.

Portfolio holdings of funds owned solely by affiliates of the investment manager may not be disclosed on the website. A complete schedule of each fund’s portfolio holdings is available semi-annually and annually in shareholder reports filed on Form N-CSR and, after the first and third fiscal quarters, in regulatory filings on Form N-Q. These shareholder reports and regulatory filings are filed with the SEC in accordance with federal securities laws and are generally available on the SEC’s website within sixty (60) days of the end of a fund’s fiscal quarter.

In addition, the investment manager makes publicly available information regarding certain fund’s largest five to fifteen holdings, as a percent of the market value of the funds’ portfolios as of a month-end. This holdings information is made publicly available through the websites (riversource.com/funds for RiverSource and Threadneedle funds and seligman.com for Seligman funds), approximately fifteen (15) days following the month-end. The scope of the information that is made available on the funds’ websites pursuant to the funds’ policies may change from time to time without prior notice.

Other Disclosures

The funds’ policies and procedures provide that no disclosures of the funds’ portfolio holdings may be made prior to the portfolio holdings information being made public unless (i) the funds have a legitimate business purpose for making such disclosure, (ii) the funds or their authorized agents authorize such non-public disclosure of information, and (iii) the party receiving the non-public information enters into an appropriate confidentiality agreement or is otherwise subject to a confidentiality obligation.

In determining the existence of a legitimate business purpose for making portfolio disclosures, the following factors, among others, are considered: (i) any prior disclosure must be consistent with the anti-fraud provisions of the federal securities laws and the fiduciary duties of the investment manager; (ii) any conflicts of interest between the interests of fund shareholders, on the one hand, and those of the investment manager, the funds’ distributor or any affiliated person of a fund, the investment manager or distributor on the other; and (iii) any prior disclosure to a third party, although subject to a confidentiality agreement, would not make conduct lawful that is otherwise unlawful.

In addition, the funds periodically disclose their portfolio information on a confidential basis to various service providers that require such information to assist the funds with their day-to-day business affairs. These service providers include each fund’s sub-advisor(s) (if any), affiliates of the investment manager, the funds’ custodian, sub-custodians, the funds’ independent registered public accounting firm, legal counsel, financial printers, proxy solicitor and proxy voting service provider, as well as ratings agencies that maintain ratings on certain funds. These service providers are required to keep such information confidential, and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information except as necessary in providing services to the funds. The funds also may disclose portfolio holdings information to broker/dealers and certain other entities in connection with potential transactions and management of the funds, provided that reasonable precautions, including limitations on the scope of the portfolio holdings information disclosed, are taken to avoid any potential misuse of the disclosed information.

 

75


Table of Contents

 

The fund also discloses holdings information as required by federal, state or international securities laws, and may disclose holdings information in response to requests by governmental authorities, or in connection with litigation or potential litigation, a restructuring of a holding, where such disclosure is necessary to participate or explore participation in a restructuring of the holding (e.g., as part of a bondholder group), or to the issuer of a holding, pursuant to a request of the issuer or any other party who is duly authorized by the issuer.

Each fund’s Board has adopted policies to ensure that the fund’s holdings information is only disclosed in accordance with these policies. Before any selective disclosure of holdings information is permitted, the person seeking to disclose such holdings information must submit a written request to the Portfolio Holdings Committee (“PHC”). The PHC is comprised of members from the investment manager’s legal department, Compliance, and the funds’ President. The PHC has been authorized by each fund’s Board to perform an initial review of requests for disclosure of holdings information to evaluate whether there is a legitimate business purpose for selective disclosure, whether selective disclosure is in the best interests of a fund and its shareholders, to consider any potential conflicts of interest between the fund, the investment manager, and its affiliates, and to safeguard against improper use of holdings information. Factors considered in this analysis are whether the recipient has agreed to or has a duty to keep the holdings information confidential and whether risks have been mitigated such that the recipient has agreed or has a duty to use the holdings information only as necessary to effectuate the purpose for which selective disclosure was authorized, including a duty not to trade on such information. Before portfolio holdings may be selectively disclosed, requests approved by the PHC must also be authorized by either the fund’s President, Chief Compliance Officer or General Counsel or their respective designees. On at least an annual basis, the PHC reviews the approved recipients of selective disclosure and may require a resubmission of the request, in order to re-authorize certain ongoing arrangements. These procedures are intended to be reasonably designed to protect the confidentiality of fund holdings information and to prohibit their release to individual investors, institutional investors, intermediaries that distribute the fund’s shares, and other parties, until such holdings information is made public or unless such persons have been authorized to receive such holdings information on a selective basis, as set forth above.

Although the investment manager has set up these procedures to monitor and control selective disclosure of holdings information, there can be no assurance that these procedures will protect a fund from the potential misuse of holdings information by individuals or firms in possession of that information.

The funds currently have ongoing arrangements with certain approved recipients with respect to the disclosure of portfolio holdings information prior to such information being made public. Portfolio holdings information disclosed to such recipients is current as of the time of its disclosure, is disclosed to each recipient solely for purposes consistent with the services described below and has been authorized in accordance with the policy. These special arrangements are described in the table below.

Ongoing Portfolio Holdings Disclosure Arrangements:

In addition to the daily information provided to the fund’s custodians, subcustodians, administrator and investment advisers, the following disclosure arrangements are in place:

 

Identity of recipient

  

Conditions/Restrictions on use of information

  

Frequency of

disclosure

Bitlathe    Website support for fund performance disclosure    Monthly
BlackRock, Inc.    For providing trading operations and portfolio management support.    Daily
Bloomberg, L.P.    For independent research of funds. Sent monthly, approximately 30 days after month end.    Monthly
Bowne & Co.    For printing of proxies and annual updates to prospectuses and SAIs.    As needed
Cenveo, Inc.    For printing of prospectuses, supplements, SAIs and shareholder reports.    As needed
Factset Research Systems    For provision of quantitative analytics, charting and fundamental data to the investment manager.    Daily
Investment Technology Group, Inc. (ITG, formerly known as Plexus Group)    For evaluation and assessment of trading activity, execution and practices by the investment manager.    Daily
InvestorTools, Inc.    Provide descriptive data for municipal securities    Daily
Morningstar, Inc.    For independent research and ranking of funds. Sent monthly, approximately 25 days after month end.    Monthly
RiskMetrics Group (formerly Institutional Shareholder Services)    Proxy voting administration and research on proxy matters.    Daily
Thomson Reuters Corp. (Lipper)    Information provided monthly with a 30 day lag to assure accuracy of Lipper Fact Sheets.    Monthly

 

76


Table of Contents

 

Proxy Voting

GENERAL GUIDELINES, POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

The funds uphold a long tradition of supporting sound and principled corporate governance. For over 30 years, the Board, which consists of a majority of independent Board members, has determined policies and voted proxies. The funds’ investment manager and the funds’ administrator, Ameriprise Financial, provide support to the Board in connection with the proxy voting process.

GENERAL GUIDELINES

Corporate Governance Matters — The Board supports proxy proposals that it believes are tied to the interests of shareholders and votes against proxy proposals that appear to entrench management. For example:

 

   

The Board generally votes in favor of proposals for an independent chairman or, if the chairman is not independent, in favor of a lead independent director.

 

   

The Board supports annual election of all directors and proposals to eliminate classes of directors.

 

   

In a routine election of directors, the Board will generally vote with management’s recommendations because the Board believes that management and nominating committees of independent directors are in the best position to know what qualifications are required of directors to form an effective board. However, the Board will generally vote against a nominee who has been assigned to the audit, compensation, or nominating committee if the nominee is not independent of management based on established criteria. The Board will also withhold support for any director who fails to attend 75% of meetings or has other activities that appear to interfere with his or her ability to commit sufficient attention to the company and, in general, will vote against nominees who are determined to have been involved in options backdating.

 

   

The Board generally supports proposals requiring director nominees to receive a majority of affirmative votes cast in order to be elected to the board, and opposes cumulative voting based on the view that each director elected should represent the interests of all shareholders.

 

   

Votes in a contested election of directors are evaluated on a case-by-case basis. In general, the Board believes that incumbent management and nominating committees, with access to more and better information, are in the best position to make strategic business decisions. However, the Board will consider an opposing slate if it makes a compelling business case for leading the company in a new direction.

Shareholder Rights Plans — The Board generally supports shareholder rights plans based on a belief that such plans force uninvited bidders to negotiate with a company’s board. The Board believes these negotiations allow time for the company to maximize value for shareholders by forcing a higher premium from a bidder, attracting a better bid from a competing bidder or allowing the company to pursue its own strategy for enhancing shareholder value. The Board supports proposals to submit shareholder rights plans to shareholders and supports limiting the vote required for approval of such plans to a majority of the votes cast.

Auditors — The Board values the independence of auditors based on established criteria. The Board supports a reasonable review of matters that may raise concerns regarding an auditor’s service that may cause the Board to vote against a management recommendation, including, for example, auditor involvement in significant financial restatements, options backdating, material weaknesses in control, attempts to limit auditor liability or situations where independence has been compromised.

Stock Option Plans and Other Management Compensation Issues — The Board expects company management to give thoughtful consideration to providing competitive long-term employee incentives directly tied to the interest of shareholders. The Board votes against proxy proposals that it believes dilute shareholder value excessively.

The Board believes that equity compensation awards can be a useful tool, when not abused, for retaining employees and giving them incentives to engage in conduct that will improve the performance of the company. In this regard, the Board generally favors minimum holding periods of stock obtained by senior management pursuant to an option plan and will vote against compensation plans for executives that it deems excessive.

Social and Corporate Policy Issues — The Board believes proxy proposals should address the business interests of the corporation. Shareholder proposals sometime seek to have the company disclose or amend certain business practices based purely on social or environmental issues rather than compelling business arguments. In general, the Board recognizes our

 

77


Table of Contents

fund shareholders are likely to have differing views of social and environmental issues and believes that these matters are primarily the responsibility of a company’s management and its board of directors.

POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

The policy of the Board is to vote all proxies of the companies in which a fund holds investments. Because of the volume and complexity of the proxy voting process, including inherent inefficiencies in the process that are outside the control of the Board or the Proxy Team (as defined below), not all proxies may be voted. The Board has implemented policies and procedures that have been reasonably designed to vote proxies and to ensure that there are no conflicts between interests of a fund’s shareholders and those of the funds’ principal underwriters, Columbia Management, or other affiliated persons. In exercising its proxy voting responsibilities, the Board may rely upon the research or recommendations of one or more third party service providers.

The administration of the proxy voting process is handled by the Columbia Management Proxy Administration Team (“Proxy Team”). In exercising its responsibilities, the Proxy Team may rely upon one or more third party service providers. The Proxy Team assists the Board in identifying situations where its guidelines do not clearly require a vote in a particular manner and assists in researching matters and making voting recommendations. Columbia Management may recommend that a proxy be voted in a manner contrary to the Board’s guidelines. In making recommendations to the Board about voting on a proposal, the investment manager relies on its own investment personnel (or the investment personnel of a fund’s subadviser(s)) and information obtained from an independent research firm. The investment manager makes the recommendation in writing. The process requires that Board members who are independent from the investment manager consider the recommendation and decide how to vote the proxy proposal or establish a protocol for voting the proposal.

On an annual basis, or more frequently as determined necessary, the Board reviews recommendations to revise the existing guidelines or add new guidelines. Recommendations are based on, among other things, industry trends and the frequency that similar proposals appear on company ballots.

The Board considers management’s recommendations as set out in the company’s proxy statement. In each instance in which a fund votes against management’s recommendation (except when withholding votes from a nominated director), the Board sends a letter to senior management of the company explaining the basis for its vote. This permits both the company’s management and the Board to have an opportunity to gain better insight into issues presented by the proxy proposal(s).

Voting in Countries Outside the United States (Non-U.S. Countries) — Voting proxies for companies not domiciled in the United States may involve greater effort and cost due to the variety of regulatory schemes and corporate practices. For example, certain non-U.S. countries require securities to be blocked prior to a vote, which means that the securities to be voted may not be traded within a specified number of days before the shareholder meeting. The Board typically will not vote securities in non-U.S. countries that require securities to be blocked as the need for liquidity of the securities in the funds will typically outweigh the benefit of voting. There may be additional costs associated with voting in non-U.S. countries such that the Board may determine that the cost of voting outweighs the potential benefit.

Securities on Loan — The Board will generally refrain from recalling securities on loan based upon its determination that the costs and lost revenue to the funds, combined with the administrative effects of recalling the securities, generally outweigh the benefit of voting the proxy. While neither the Board nor the funds’ administrator assesses the economic impact and benefits of voting loaned securities on a case-by-case basis, situations may arise where the Board requests that loaned securities be recalled in order to vote a proxy. In this regard, if a proxy relates to matters that may impact the nature of a company, such as a proposed merger or acquisition, and the funds’ ownership position is more significant, the Board has established a guideline to direct the funds’ administrator to use its best efforts to recall such securities based upon its determination that, in these situations, the benefits of voting such proxies generally outweigh the costs or lost revenue to the funds, or any potential adverse administrative effects to the funds, of not recalling such securities.

Investment in Affiliated Funds — Certain funds may invest in shares of other funds in the Fund Family (referred to in this context as “underlying funds”) and may own substantial portions of these underlying funds. The proxy policy of the funds is to ensure that direct public shareholders of underlying funds control the outcome of any shareholder vote. To help manage this potential conflict of interest, recognizing that the direct public shareholders of these underlying funds may represent only a minority interest, the policy of the funds is to vote proxies of the underlying funds in the same proportion as the vote of the direct public shareholders. If there are no direct public shareholders of an underlying fund, the policy is to cast votes in accordance with instructions from the independent members of the Board.

 

78


Table of Contents

 

OBTAIN A PROXY VOTING RECORD

Each year the funds file their proxy voting records with the SEC and make them available by August 31 for the 12-month period ending June 30 of that year. The records can be obtained without charge through riversource.com/funds or searching the website of the SEC at www.sec.gov.

Investing in a Fund

The Columbia funds and Columbia Acorn funds and portfolios are collectively referred to as the Legacy Columbia funds (see Appendix E). The RiverSource funds (including the Seligman and Threadneedle branded funds) are collectively referred to as the Legacy RiverSource funds (see Appendix F).

SALES CHARGE

Investors should understand that the purpose and function of the initial sales charge and distribution fee for Class A shares is the same as the purpose and function of the contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) and distribution fee for Class B and Class C shares. The sales charges and distribution fees applicable to each class pay for the distribution of shares of a fund.

Shares of a fund are sold at the class’ public offering price. For funds other than money market funds and, as noted below in Table 9, certain other funds, the public offering price for Class A shares is the NAV of one share adjusted for the sales charge applicable to the class. For money market funds and, as noted below in Table 9, certain other funds, the public offering price is the NAV. For all funds, for Class B, Class C, Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class W and Class Z there is no initial sales charge so the public offering price is the same as the NAV.

Class A – Calculation of the Sales Charge

Sales charges are determined as shown in the following tables. The table is organized by investment category. You can find your fund’s investment category in Table 1.

Table 9. Class A Initial Sales Charge

 

    Sales charge(a) as  a percentage of:  

Fund category

   Total market value   Public  offering
price(b)
    Net amount
invested
 

Balanced, Equity, Fund-of-funds – equity*

   $0 – $49,999     5.75     6.10
   $50,000 – $99,999     4.50     4.71
   $100,000 – $249,999     3.50     3.63
   $250,000 – $499,999     2.50     2.56
   $500,000 – $999,999     2.00     2.04
   $1,000,000 or  more(c),(d)     0.00     0.00
   $0 – $49,999     4.75     4.99
   $50,000 – $99,999     4.25     4.44

Fund-of-funds – fixed income, State tax-exempt fixed income, Taxable fixed income, Tax-exempt fixed income

   $100,000 – $249,999     3.50     3.63
   $250,000 – $499,999     2.50     2.56
   $500,000 – $999,999     2.00     2.04
   $1,000,000 or  more(c),(d)     0.00     0.00

For Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund, Columbia Floating Rate Fund, Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund, Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund, RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund and RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

   $0 – $99,999     3.00     3.09
   $100,000 – $249,999     2.50     2.56
   $250,000 – $499,999     2.00     2.04
   $500,000 – $999,999     1.50     1.52
   $1,000,000 or  more(c),(d)     0.00     0.00

 

* RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund is not subject to a front-end sales change on Class A shares.

 

79


Table of Contents
(a) Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process.
(b) Purchase price includes the sales charge.
(c) Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the distributor may pay a selling and/or servicing agent the following out of its own resources: 1.00% on purchases from $1 million up to but not including $3 million; 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and 0.25% on amounts of $50 million or more. The distributor may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are redeemed.
(d) For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the distributor the following sales commissions on purchases that are coded as commission eligible trades: 1.00% on all purchases up to but not including $3 million, including those in amounts of less than $1 million; up to 0.50% on all purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and up to 0.25% on all purchases of $50 million or more.

Using the sales charge schedule in the table above, for Class A, the public offering price for an investment of less than $50,000, made on the last day of the most recent fiscal period, was determined as shown in the following table. The sales charge is paid to the distributor by the person buying the shares. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 10. Public Offering Price

 

Fund

   Net asset
value
     1.0 minus maximum
sales charge
     Public offering price  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

  

     

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   $ 9.76         0.9525       $ 10.25   

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     9.47         0.9525         9.94   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     9.44         0.9525         9.91   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     8.62         0.9425         9.15   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     9.77         0.9525         10.26   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     9.46         0.9425         10.04   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     9.03         0.9425         9.58   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     9.61         0.9525         10.09   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     8.20         0.9425         8.70   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index (for Class D, now known as Class A)

     3.55         No sales charge         3.55   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     3.90         0.9425         4.14   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

        

Columbia Equity Value

     9.63         0.9425         10.22   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     12.22         0.9425         12.97   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

        

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     15.27         0.9425         16.20   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     19.66         0.9425         20.86   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     8.53         0.9425         9.05   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     8.53         0.9425         9.05   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     8.06         0.9425         8.55   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     8.06         0.9425         8.55   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     8.08         0.9425         8.57   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     7.99         0.9425         8.48   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     7.77         0.9425         8.24   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     7.93         0.9425         8.41   

 

80


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Net asset
value
     1.0 minus maximum
sales charge
     Public offering price  

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

        

Columbia High Yield Bond

     2.61         0.9525         2.74   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     4.91         0.9425         5.21   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     5.16         0.9525         5.42   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     4.36         0.9425         4.63   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     4.75         0.9700         4.90   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

        

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

     6.31         0.9425         6.69   

RiverSource Real Estate

     9.23         0.9425         9.79   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

        

Columbia Floating Rate

     8.54         0.9700         8.80   

Columbia Income Opportunities

     9.72         0.9525         10.20   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     10.36         0.9700         10.68   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     4.74         0.9425         5.03   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     9.94         0.9700         10.25   

Columbia Money Market

     1.00         No sales charge         1.00   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     7.41         0.9425         7.86   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     7.89         0.9425         8.37   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

        

Columbia Diversified Bond

     5.07         0.9525         5.32   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     5.47         0.9525         5.74   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     5.16         0.9525         5.42   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     5.13         0.9525         5.39   

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

        

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

     8.31         0.9425         8.82   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     7.50         0.9425         7.96   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     7.78         0.9425         8.25   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     6.15         0.9425         6.53   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     8.44         0.9425         8.95   

RiverSource Balanced

     8.79         0.9425         9.33   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     9.60         0.9525         10.08   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

     6.69         0.9525         7.02   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

     6.69         0.9525         7.02   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

     7.79         0.9525         8.18   

Seligman National Municipal

     8.12         0.9525         8.52   

Seligman New York Municipal

     8.32         0.9525         8.73   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     6.63         0.9425         7.03   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     6.84         0.9425         7.26   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     7.09         0.9425         7.52   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     7.06         0.9425         7.49   

Seligman TargETFund Core

     6.44         0.9425         6.83   

 

81


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Net asset
value
     1.0 minus maximum
sales charge
     Public offering price  

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

        

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

     9.93         0.9700         10.24   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan (for Class R5)

     11.42         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     10.35         0.9525         10.87   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     7.74         0.9425         8.21   

Columbia European Equity

     4.86         0.9425         5.16   

Columbia Frontier

     8.21         0.9425         8.71   

Columbia Global Bond

     7.10         0.9525         7.45   

Columbia Global Equity

     6.13         0.9425         6.50   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     17.65         0.9425         18.73   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

     5.67         0.9425         6.02   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

     16.50         0.9425         17.51   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     6.98         0.9425         7.41   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     5.80         0.9425         6.15   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     5.08         0.9425         5.39   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

     8.49         0.9425         9.01   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     7.70         0.9425         8.17   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

        

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     3.72         0.9525         3.91   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     8.58         0.9425         9.10   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     5.26         0.9700         5.42   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     4.19         0.9525         4.40   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

        

Columbia Government Money Market

     1.00         No sales charge         1.00   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     12.31         0.9425         13.06   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     12.59         0.9425         13.36   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     38.78         0.9425         41.15   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     3.49         0.9425         3.70   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     3.62         0.9425         3.84   

Seligman Capital

     20.09         0.9425         21.32   

Seligman Growth

     4.07         0.9425         4.32   

Class A — Statement or Letter of Intent (LOI)

If you intend to invest $50,000 or more over a period of time, you may be able to reduce the sales charge you pay on investments in Class A, Class E or Class T shares by completing a LOI form and committing to invest a certain amount. The LOI must be filed with and accepted in good order by the distributor of the funds. You will have up to 13 months from the date of your LOI to fulfill your commitment. Existing Rights of Accumulation (ROA) can be included for purposes of meeting your commitment under the LOI. For example, a shareholder currently has $60,000 ROA in the funds. Shareholder completes an LOI to invest $100,000 in the funds (ROA eligible accounts). Shareholder only needs to invest an additional $40,000 in the funds’ Class A shares over the next 13 months in order to fulfill the LOI commitment, during which time the shareholder receives reduced front-end sales charge(s) on investments. Your investments during this 13-month period will be charged the sales charge that applies to the amount you have committed to invest under the LOI. A portion of your commitment will be invested in Class A, Class E or Class T shares, as the case may be, and placed in escrow. At the end of the 13-month period, the LOI will end and the shares will be released from escrow (less any amount necessary to pay sales charges to the extent the LOI commitment was not met, as described below). Once the LOI has ended or your investments entitle you to a lower sale charge than would otherwise be available to you under the LOI, future sales charges will be determined by Rights of Accumulation (ROA) as described in the prospectus. If you do not invest the commitment amount by the end of the 13-month period, the remaining unpaid sales charge will be redeemed from the escrowed shares and the remaining balance released from escrow. For purposes of making an LOI to purchase additional shares, you may aggregate your ownership of different classes of shares, except Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares. For

 

82


Table of Contents

example, if your LOI commits you to purchases Class A shares, the commitment amount does not include purchases in these classes of shares; does not include any new reinvested dividends and directed dividends earned in any funds during the 13-month period; and purchases of money market funds unless they are subsequently exchanged for shares of a non-money market fund (other than Class I, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5 and Class Y shares of such non-money market fund) within the 13-month period. A LOI is not an option (absolute right) to buy shares. If you purchase shares through different channels, for example, in a brokerage account or through a third party, you must inform your financial intermediary in writing about the LOI when placing any purchase orders during the period of the LOI. If you do not complete and file the LOI form, or do not request the reduced sales charge at the time of purchase, you will not be eligible for the reduced sales charge.

Class A Shares

Class A shares may be sold at net asset value to certain persons since such sales require less sales effort and lower sales-related expenses as compared with sales to the general public. If you are eligible to purchase Class A shares without a sales charge, you should inform your financial advisor, selling and/or servicing agent or the fund’s transfer agent of such eligibility and be prepared to provide proof thereof. For Class A shares purchased without a sales charge where a commission was separately paid by the distributor to a selling and/or servicing agent effecting the purchase, a CDSC may be charged if you sell your shares within, except as provided below, 18 months after purchase, charged as follows: a 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase. A CDSC is based on the original purchase cost or the current market value of the shares being sold, whichever is less.

Initial Sales Charge — Waivers of the sales charge for Class A shares. Sales charges do not apply to:

 

   

shareholders whose original purchase was in a Strategist fund merged into a RiverSource fund in 2000.

 

   

participants of “eligible employee benefit plans” including 403(b) plans for which Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc. (Ameriprise Financial Services) serves as broker-dealer, and the school district or group received a written proposal from Ameriprise Financial Services between November 1, 2007 and Dec. 31, 2008 (each a Qualifying 403(b) Plan). In order for participants in one of these 403(b) plans to receive this waiver, at least one participant account of the 403(b) plan must have been funded at Ameriprise Financial Services prior to Dec. 31, 2009. This waiver may be discontinued for any Qualifying 403(b) Plan, in the sole discretion of the distributor, after Dec. 31, 2009.

 

   

to separate accounts established and maintained by an insurance company which are exempt from registration under Section 3(c)(11) of the 1940 Act.

 

   

plans that (i) own Class B shares of any Seligman fund and (ii) participate in Seligman Growth 401(k) through Ascensus’s (formerly BISYS) third party administration platform may, with new contributions, purchase Class A shares at net asset value. Class A shares purchased at net asset value on or prior to Sept. 3, 2010 are subject to a CDSC on shares purchased within 18 months prior to plan termination, charged as follows: 1.00% CDSC if redeemed within 12 months of purchase, and 0.50% CDSC if redeemed more than 12, but less than 18, months after purchase.

 

   

to participants in retirement and deferred compensation plans and trusts used to fund those plans, including but not limited to, those defined in Sections 401(a), 401(k), 403(b) or 457 of the Internal Revenue Code and “rabbi trusts” for which Charles Schwab & Co., Inc. acts as broker dealer.

 

   

to participants in plans established at the transfer agent (Seligman funds only) prior to January 7, 2008, the plan had $500,000 or 50 participants when the shares were initially purchased.

 

   

to participants in retirement and benefit plans made through financial intermediaries that perform participant recordkeeping or other administrative services for the plans and that have entered into special arrangements as alliance program partners with the funds and/or the distributor specifically for such purchases.

 

   

to other funds pursuant to a “fund-of-funds” arrangement provided that the fund is distributed by the distributor.

 

   

any shareholder who owned shares of any fund of Columbia Acorn Trust (formerly named Liberty Acorn Trust) on September 29, 2000 (when all of the then outstanding shares of Columbia Acorn Trust were re-designated Class Z shares) and who since that time remained a shareholder of any Fund, may buy Class A shares of any Fund without paying a front-end sales charge in those cases when Class Z shares is not available.

 

   

Galaxy Fund shareholders prior to December 1, 1995; and shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Prime A shares without paying a front-end sales charge and received Class A shares in exchange for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Prime A shares were originally bought.

 

83


Table of Contents

 

Initial Sales Charge — Waivers of the sales charge for Class T shares.

 

   

(For Class T shares only) Shareholders who (i) bought Galaxy Fund Retail A shares at net asset value and received Class T shares in exchanges for those shares during the Galaxy/Liberty Fund reorganization; and (ii) continue to maintain the account in which the Retail A shares were originally bought; and Boston 1784 Fund shareholders on the date those funds were reorganized into Galaxy Funds.

CDSC — Waivers of the CDSC for Class A, Class C, Class E, and Class T shares. The CDSC will be waived on sales of Class A, Class C, Class E, and Class T shares:

 

   

in connection with participation in the Merrill Lynch Small Market 401(k) Program, retirement programs administered or serviced by the Princeton Retirement Group, Paychex, ADP Retirement Services, Hartford Securities Distribution Company, Inc. or NYLIM Service Company LLC, retirement programs or accounts administered or serviced by Mercer HR Services, LLC or its affiliates, or retirement programs or accounts administered or serviced by firms that have a written agreement with the distributor that contemplates a waiver of CDSCs, provided that no sales commission or transaction fee was paid to such authorized financial institution at the time of purchase.

The CDSC will be waived on sales of Class A, Class B and Class C shares of a Legacy Columbia fund purchased prior to September 7, 2010:

 

   

after the sole shareholder on an individual account or a joint tenant on a joint tenant account becomes disabled (as defined by Section 72(m)(7) of the Internal Revenue Code). To be eligible for such a waiver: (i) the disability must arise after the account is opened and (ii) a letter from a physician must be signed under penalty of perjury stating the nature of the disability. If the account is transferred to a new registration and then shares are sold, the applicable CDSC will be charged.*

 

   

by health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by affiliates of Bank of America.*

 

   

for the following purposes (i) to make medical payments that exceed 7.5% of income and (ii) to pay for insurance by an individual who has separated from employment and who has received unemployment compensation under a federal or state program for at least twelve weeks.*

 

   

pursuant to the Fund’s Systematic Withdrawal Plan established with the Transfer Agent, to the extent that the sales do not exceed, on an annual basis, 12% of the account’s value as long as distributions are reinvested. Otherwise, a CDSC will be charged on sales through the Fund’s Systematic Withdrawal Plan until this requirement is met.

 

   

in connection with distributions from qualified retirement plans, government (Section 457) plans, individual retirement accounts or custodial accounts under Section 403(b)(7) of the Internal Revenue Code following normal retirement or the attainment of age 59 1/2.**

 

   

in connection with loans from qualified retirement plans to shareholders.*

 

* Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the fund or the transfer agent in writing that the fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.
** For direct trades on non-prototype retirement accounts where the date of birth of the fund shareholder is not maintained, the shareholder or selling and/or servicing agent must inform the fund or the transfer agent in writing that the Fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

Class B Shares — Closed

The funds no longer accept investments from new or existing investors in Class B shares, except for certain limited transactions involving existing investors in Class B shares as described in more detail in the fund’s prospectus.

Class B shares have a CDSC. For purposes of calculating the CDSC on shares of a fund purchased after the close of business on Sept. 3, 2010, the start of the holding period is the first day of the month in which your purchase was made. For purposes of calculating the CDSC on shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund purchased on or before the close of business on Sept. 3, 2010, the start of the holding period is the date your purchase was made. When you place an order to sell your Class B shares, the fund will first redeem any shares that aren’t subject to a CDSC, followed by those you have held the longest. This means that if a CDSC is imposed, you cannot designate the individual shares being redeemed for federal income tax purposes. You should consult your tax advisor about the tax consequences of investing in the funds.

CDSC — Waivers of the CDSC for Class B shares. The CDSC will be waived on sales of shares:

 

   

in connection with participation in the Merrill Lynch Small Market 401(k) Program, retirement programs administered or serviced by the Princeton Retirement Group, Paychex, ADP Retirement Services, Hartford Securities

 

84


Table of Contents
 

Distribution Company, Inc. or NYLIM Service Company LLC, retirement programs or accounts administered or serviced by Mercer HR Services, LLC or its affiliates, or retirement programs or accounts administered or serviced by firms that have a written agreement with the distributor that contemplates a waiver of CDSCs, provided that no sales commission or transaction fee was paid to such authorized financial institution at the time of purchase.

 

   

of Legacy RiverSource funds held in investment-only accounts (i.e. accounts where Ameriprise Trust Company does not act as the custodian) at Ameriprise Financial Services on behalf of a trust for an employee benefit plan.

 

   

of Legacy RiverSource funds held in IRAs or certain qualified plans, on or prior to June 12, 2009, such as Keogh plans, tax-sheltered custodial accounts or corporate pension plans where Ameriprise Trust Company is acting as custodian, provided that the shareholder is:

 

   

at least 59 1/2 years old and taking a retirement distribution (if the sale is part of a transfer to an IRA or qualified plan, or a custodian-to-custodian transfer, the CDSC will not be waived)*, or

 

   

selling under an approved substantially equal periodic payment arrangement.

 

   

of sales of Class B shares of Legacy RiverSource funds purchased prior to Sept. 7, 2010 sold under an approved substantially equal periodic payment arrangement (applies to retirement accounts when a shareholder sets up an arrangement with the Internal Revenue Service).**

 

* You must notify the fund or the transfer agent prior to redeeming shares of the applicability of the CDSC waiver, but final decision of the applicability of the CDSC waiver is contingent on approval of the fund or the transfer agent.
** Fund investors and selling and/or servicing agents must inform the fund or the transfer agent in writing that the fund investor qualifies for the particular sales charge waiver and provide proof thereof.

Class C Shares

Class C shares are available to all investors. Class C shares are sold without a front-end sales charge. For Class C shares, a 1% CDSC may apply if shares are sold within one year after purchase. Class C shares are subject to a distribution fee.

Class I Shares

Class I shares are only available to the funds. Class I shares are sold without a front-end sales charge or CDSC.

Class R, Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 Shares

Class R, Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are offered to certain institutional investors identified in the fund’s prospectus. Class R, Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares are sold without a front-end sales charge or a CDSC. Class R and Class R3 shares are subject to a distribution fee (for Class R shares of a Legacy RiverSource fund, a portion of such fee may be paid for shareholder services). Class R3 and R4 shares are subject to a plan administration fee (which is not a 12b-1 related free). The following investors are eligible to purchase Class R, Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares:

Class R Shares (formerly Class R2 shares)

Class R shares are available to eligible health savings accounts sponsored by third party platforms, including those sponsored by affiliates of Ameriprise Financial, and the following eligible retirement plans:

 

   

401(k) plans; 457 plans;

 

   

employer-sponsored 403(b) plans;

 

   

profit sharing and money purchase pension plans;

 

   

defined benefit plans; and

 

   

non-qualified deferred compensation plans.

Class R shares are not available for investment through retail nonretirement accounts, traditional and Roth IRAs, Coverdell Education Savings Accounts, SEPs, SAR-SEPs, Simple IRAs, individual 403(b) plans or 529 tuition programs. Contact the funds or your retirement plan or health savings account administrator for more information about investing in Class R shares.

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 Shares

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 shares will be closed to new investors as of the close of business on Dec. 31, 2010.

Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5 are available to:

 

   

Qualified employee benefit plans;

 

85


Table of Contents

 

   

Trust companies or similar institutions, and charitable organizations that meet the definition in Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code;

 

   

Nonqualified deferred compensation plans;

 

   

State sponsored college savings plans established under Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code; and

 

   

Health Savings Accounts (HSAs) created pursuant to public law 108-173.

Additionally, the following eligible investors may purchase Class R5 shares:

 

   

Institutional or corporate accounts above a threshold established by the distributor (currently $1 million per fund or $10 million in all funds); and

 

   

Bank Trusts.

Class W Shares

Class W shares are offered to qualifying discretionary accounts. Class W shares are sold without a front-end sales charge or CDSC. Class W shares are subject to a distribution fee.

Class Z Shares

Class Z shares are sold without a front-end sales charge or a CDSC.

Class Z shares are available only to certain eligible investors, which are subject to different minimum initial investment requirements described in the prospectus and the SAI. In addition to the categories of Class Z investors described in the prospectus, the minimum initial investment in Class Z shares is as follows:

There is no minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following categories of eligible investors:

 

   

Any health savings account sponsored by a third party platform, including those sponsored by affiliates of Bank of America

The minimum initial investment in Class Z shares for the following categories of eligible investors is $2,000:

 

   

Any client of Bank of America or one of its subsidiaries buying shares through an asset management company, trust, fiduciary, retirement plan administration or similar arrangement with Bank of America or the subsidiary.

 

   

Any employee (or family member of an employee) of Bank of America or one of its subsidiaries.

In addition, for Class I, Class R, Class W and Class Z shares, the distributor, in its sole discretion, may accept investments from other purchasers not listed above.

FUND REORGANIZATIONS

Class A shares may be issued without an initial sales charge in connection with the acquisition of cash and securities owned by other investment companies. Any CDSC will be waived in connection with the redemption of shares of the fund if the fund is combined with another fund or in connection with a similar reorganization transaction.

REJECTION OF BUSINESS

Each fund and the distributor of the funds reserve the right to reject any business, in their sole discretion.

Selling Shares

You have a right to sell your shares at any time. For an explanation of sales procedures, please see the applicable prospectus.

During an emergency, the Board can suspend the computation of NAV, stop accepting payments for purchase of shares, or suspend the duty of a fund to redeem shares for more than seven days. Such emergency situations would occur if:

 

   

The Exchange closes for reasons other than the usual weekend and holiday closings or trading on the Exchange is restricted, or

 

   

Disposal of a fund’s securities is not reasonably practicable or it is not reasonably practicable for the fund to determine the fair value of its net assets, or,

 

   

The SEC, under the provisions of the 1940 Act, declares a period of emergency to exist.

 

86


Table of Contents

 

Should a fund stop selling shares, the Board may make a deduction from the value of the assets held by the fund to cover the cost of future liquidations of the assets so as to distribute these costs fairly among all shareholders.

Each fund has elected to be governed by Rule 18f-1 under the 1940 Act, which obligates the fund to redeem shares in cash, with respect to any one shareholder during any 90-day period, up to the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the net assets of the fund at the beginning of the period. Although redemptions in excess of this limitation would normally be paid in cash, the fund reserves the right to make these payments in whole or in part in securities or other assets in case of an emergency, or if the payment of a redemption in cash would be detrimental to the existing shareholders of the fund as determined by the Board. In these circumstances, the securities distributed would be valued as set forth in this SAI. Should a fund distribute securities, a shareholder may incur brokerage fees or other transaction costs in converting the securities to cash.

Pay-out Plans

You can use any of several pay-out plans to redeem your investment in regular installments. If you redeem shares, you may be subject to a contingent deferred sales charge as discussed in the prospectus. While the plans differ on how the pay-out is figured, they all are based on the redemption of your investment. Net investment income dividends and any capital gain distributions will automatically be reinvested, unless you elect to receive them in cash. If you redeem an IRA or a qualified retirement account, certain restrictions, federal tax penalties, and special federal income tax reporting requirements may apply. You should consult your tax advisor about this complex area of the tax law.

Applications for a systematic investment in a class of a fund subject to a sales charge normally will not be accepted while a pay-out plan for any of those funds is in effect. Occasional investments, however, may be accepted.

To start any of these plans, please consult your financial intermediary. Your authorization must be received at least five days before the date you want your payments to begin. Payments will be made on a monthly, bimonthly, quarterly, semiannual, or annual basis. Your choice is effective until you change or cancel it.

 

87


Table of Contents

 

Capital Loss Carryover

For federal income tax purposes, certain funds had total capital loss carryovers at the end of the most recent fiscal period that, if not offset by subsequent capital gains, will expire as provided in the table below. Because the measurement periods for a regulated investment company’s income are different for excise tax purposes verses income tax purposes, special rules are in place to protect the amount of earnings and profits needed to support excise tax distributions. As a result, the funds are permitted to treat net capital losses realized between November 1 and its fiscal year end (“post-October loss”) as occurring on the first day of the following tax year. The total capital loss carryovers below include post-October losses, if applicable. It is unlikely that the Board will authorize a distribution of any net realized capital gains until the available capital loss carryover has been offset or has expired except as required by Internal Revenue Service rules. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 11. Capital Loss Carryover

 

Fund

  Total
Capital Loss
Carryovers
       
    Amount Expiring in  
    2011     2012     2013     2014     2015     2016     2017     2018     2019  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

  

                 

Columbia Income Builder Fund

  $ 19,447,298      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,942,103      $ 15,861,057      $ 644,138   

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

  $ 59,928,714      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 7,376,558      $ 51,037,474      $ 1,514,682   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

  $ 37,439,030      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 5,920,892      $ 31,518,138      $ 0   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

  $ 37,879,654      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 6,629,032      $ 28,221,611      $ 3,029,011   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

  $ 4,428,658      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,265,389      $ 163,269   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

  $ 48,604,696      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 7,597,638      $ 37,758,600      $ 3,248,458   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

  $ 68,142,574      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,898,399      $ 57,879,727      $ 5,364,448   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

  $ 17,455,318      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,062,939      $ 15,811,121      $ 581,258   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

  $ 42,147,214      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 7,784,164      $ 30,165,767      $ 4,197,283   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

  $ 4,733,437      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,980,165      $ 235,890      $ 66,065      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,105,466      $ 345,851   

RiverSource Small Company Index

  $ 43,209,451      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 41,195,692      $ 2,013,759   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

  

                 

Columbia Equity Value

  $ 133,819,916      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 96,368      $ 40,190,239      $ 93,533,309      $ 0   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

  $ 14,911,599      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 14,911,599      $ 0      $ 0   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

  

                 

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

  $ 11,229,719      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,090,734      $ 8,138,985      $ 0   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

  $ 3,454,336      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 428,181      $ 2,827,856      $ 198,299   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

  $ 4,269,531      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 704,342      $ 3,055,770      $ 509,419   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

  $ 5,656,636      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 502,050      $ 4,705,880      $ 448,706   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

  $ 4,543,260      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 662,473      $ 3,488,786      $ 392,001   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

  $ 4,050,556      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 623,603      $ 2,895,797      $ 531,156   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

  $ 1,679,848      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 312,553      $ 1,217,126      $ 150,169   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

  $ 955,784      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 370,260      $ 565,348      $ 20,176   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

  $ 468,723      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 84,212      $ 248,395      $ 136,116   

 

88


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  Total
Capital Loss
Carryovers
       
    Amount Expiring in  
    2011     2012     2013     2014     2015     2016     2017     2018     2019  

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

  

               

Columbia High Yield Bond

  $ 815,795,304      $ 552,664,309      $ 0      $ 0      $ 19,078,058      $ 0      $ 9,388,877      $ 179,604,128      $ 55,059,932      $ 0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

  $ 66,320,839      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 20,926,946      $ 45,393,893      $ 0   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

  $ 12,077,144      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 410,120      $ 11,667,024      $ 0   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

  $ 113,804,431      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 26,053,833      $ 82,755,092      $ 4,995,506   

RiverSource Short Duration

U.S. Government

  $ 93,995,687      $ 0      $ 1,261,719      $ 38,180,597      $ 22,499,962      $ 9,579,187      $ 0      $ 3,846,817      $ 18,627,405      $ 0   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

  

               

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

  $ 573,711,900      $ 343,927,468      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 36,972,874      $ 165,774,622      $ 27,036,936   

RiverSource Real Estate

  $ 45,007,629      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,114,883      $ 43,892,746      $ 0   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

  

               

Columbia Floating Rate

  $ 69,735,278      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 33,562      $ 3,488,601      $ 29,093,899      $ 35,393,394      $ 1,725,822   

Columbia Income Opportunities

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

  $ 17,202,378      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 8,424,851      $ 8,777,527      $ 0   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

  $ 2,641,007,182      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 420,044,596      $ 1,377,208,066      $ 628,476,902      $ 215,277,618   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

  $ 9,271,761      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,206,552      $ 0      $ 825,807      $ 4,896,866      $ 1,342,536   

Columbia Money Market

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid

Cap Equity

  $ 7,615,730      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 7,615,730      $ 0      $ 0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

  $ 6,228,634      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 6,228,634      $ 0      $ 0   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

  

               

Columbia Diversified Bond

  $ 22,648,830      $ 0      $ 5,227,159      $ 3,354,885      $ 10,357,129      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,709,657      $ 0      $ 0   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

  $ 173,241      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 173,241      $ 0      $ 0   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

  $ 2,029,072      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 359,905      $ 1,247,347      $ 421,820      $ 0   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

  $ 643,568      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,664      $ 341,015      $ 298,889      $ 0   
          2010     2011     2012     2013     2014     2015     2016     2017     2018  

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

  

               

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

  $ 1,110,095,393      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 46,346,713      $ 1,063,748,680   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

  $ 41,243,744      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 14,271,533      $ 26,972,211   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

  $ 566,727,070      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 47,902,744      $ 518,824,326   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

  $ 346,850,712      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 21,514,298      $ 325,336,414   

RiverSource Balanced

  $ 888,451,981      $ 294,910,142      $ 368,676,980      $ 24,886,878      $ 0      $ 0      $ 8,027,521      $ 22,923,709      $ 38,698,637      $ 130,328,114   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

  $ 11,336,901      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 631,381      $ 10,705,520   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Seligman California Municipal Quality

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Seligman National Municipal

  $ 2,099,958      $ 996,330      $ 0      $ 505,484      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 598,144      $ 0      $ 0   

Seligman New York Municipal

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Seligman TargETFund 2015

  $ 7,102,014      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,531,175      $ 5,570,839   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

  $ 1,803,909      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 158,889      $ 1,645,020   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

  $ 256,357      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 40,056      $ 216,301   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

  $ 541,844      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 25,322      $ 516,522   

Seligman TargETFund Core

  $ 12,588,348      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 901,259      $ 11,687,089   

 

89


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  Total
Capital Loss
Carryovers
       
    Amount Expiring in  
    2011     2012     2013     2014     2015     2016     2017     2018     2019  

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

  

               

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

  $ 5,945,153      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 5,945,153      $ 0   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

  $ 0        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

  $ 17,157,025      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,399,388      $ 14,757,637      $ 0   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

  $ 98,672,638      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 28,498,591      $ 70,174,047      $ 0   

Columbia European Equity

  $ 44,533,168      $ 16,514,517      $ 5,021,215      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 4,272,956      $ 18,724,480      $ 0   

Columbia Frontier

  $ 8,888,714      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 1,048,243      $ 7,840,471      $ 0   

Columbia Global Bond

  $ 15,099,745      $ 3,665,049      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 498,771      $ 0      $ 2,328,738      $ 8,607,187      $ 0   

Columbia Global Equity

  $ 339,519,748      $ 143,688,441      $ 30,509,951      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 2,715,902      $ 62,625,028      $ 99,980,426      $ 0   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

  $ 1,407,944      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 577,229      $ 830,715      $ 0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

  $ 340,858,587      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 340,858,587      $ 0   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

  $ 294,571,144      $ 193,291,798      $ 17,073,210      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 17,310,562      $ 37,526,708      $ 29,368,866      $ 0   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

  $ 285,672,442      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 23,521,188      $ 262,151,254      $ 0   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

  $ 185,090,340      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 823,328      $ 67,466,960      $ 116,800,052      $ 0   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

  $ 36,130,012      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 16,740,416      $ 19,389,596      $ 0   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

  $ 1,477,274      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 182,867      $ 1,294,407      $ 0   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

  $ 204,715,335      $ 59,231,998      $ 38,262,972      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 12,069,463      $ 95,150,902      $ 0   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

  

               

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

  $ 66,514,603      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 20,714,703      $ 45,799,900      $ 0   

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

  $ 18,155,779      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 729,269      $ 0      $ 9,046,561      $ 8,379,949      $ 0   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

  $ 88,820,109      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 30,950,938      $ 57,869,171      $ 0   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

  $ 704,163      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 177,579      $ 0      $ 361,418      $ 165,166      $ 0   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

  

               

Columbia Government Money Market

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

  $ 3,224,311      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 3,224,311   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

  $ 153,343,213      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 22,627,649      $ 115,478,130      $ 15,237,434      $ 0   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

  $ 207,486,080      $ 0      $ 12,308,398      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 97,889,818      $ 97,287,864      $ 0   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

  $ 16,375,351      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 585,168      $ 5,289,122      $ 9,426,119      $ 1,074,942   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

  $ 40,689,222      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 14,370,083      $ 26,294,548      $ 24,591   

Seligman Capital

  $ 176,270,293      $ 50,722,077      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 63,824,881      $ 60,299,879      $ 1,423,456   

Seligman Growth

  $ 1,416,163,210      $ 234,134,706      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 107,614,532      $ 1,048,921,057      $ 25,492,915      $ 0   

 

90


Table of Contents

 

Taxes

Subchapter M Compliance

Each fund has elected to be taxed under Subchapter M of the Internal Revenue Code as a regulated investment company. Each fund intends to maintain its qualification as a regulated investment company by meeting certain requirements relating to distributions, source of income, and asset diversification. Distribution requirements include distributing at least 90% of the fund’s investment company taxable income (which includes net short-term capital gains) and tax-exempt ordinary income to fund shareholders each taxable year. The source of income rules require that at least 90% of the fund’s gross income be derived from dividends, interest, certain payments with respect to securities loans, gain from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities or foreign currencies (subject to certain limitations), and certain other income derived with respect to its business of investing in stock, securities or currencies, and net income from certain interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships. Asset diversification requirements are met when the fund owns, at the end of each quarter of its taxable year, a portfolio, 50% of which includes cash and cash items, U.S. government securities, securities of other regulated investment companies and, securities of other issuers in which the fund has not invested more than 5% of the value of the fund’s assets (or 10% of the value of the outstanding voting securities of any one issuer). Also, no more than 25% of the fund’s assets may be invested in the securities of any one issuer or two or more issuers which the fund controls and which are engaged in the same or similar trades or businesses (excepting U.S. government securities and securities of other regulated investment companies) or the securities of one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships. This is a simplified description of the relevant laws.

If the fund fails to qualify as a regulated investment company under Subchapter M, the fund would be taxed as a corporation on the entire amount of its taxable income (including its capital gain) without a dividends paid deduction. Also, “all of” a shareholder’s distributions would generally be taxable to shareholders as qualified dividend income (QDI) (or could be treated as a return of capital, if there weren’t sufficient earnings and profits) and generally would be eligible for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate shareholders.

Under federal tax law, by the end of a calendar year a fund must declare and pay dividends representing 98% of ordinary income for that calendar year and 98% of net capital gains (both long-term and short-term) for the 12-month period ending Oct. 31 of that calendar year. The fund is subject to an excise tax equal to 4% of the excess, if any, of the amount required to be distributed over the amount actually distributed. Each fund intends to comply with federal tax law and avoid any excise tax. For purposes of the excise tax distributions, section 988 ordinary gains and losses are distributable based on an Oct. 31 year end. This is an exception to the general rule that ordinary income is paid based on a calendar year end.

The fund intends to distribute sufficient dividends within each calendar year, as well as on a fiscal year basis, to avoid income and excise taxes.

A fund may be subject to U.S. taxes resulting from holdings in passive foreign investment companies (PFIC). To avoid unfavorable tax consequences, a fund may make an election to mark to market its PFIC investments. A foreign corporation is a PFIC when 75% or more of its gross income for the taxable year is passive income or 50% or more of the average value of its assets consists of assets that produce or could produce passive income.

Income earned by a fund may have had foreign taxes imposed and withheld on it in foreign countries. Tax conventions between certain countries and the U.S. may reduce or eliminate such taxes. If more than 50% of a fund’s total assets at the close of its fiscal year consists of securities of foreign corporations, the fund will be eligible to file an election with the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) under which shareholders of the fund would be required to include their pro rata portions of foreign taxes withheld by foreign countries as gross income in their federal income tax returns. These pro rata portions of foreign taxes withheld may be taken as a credit or deduction in computing the shareholders’ federal income taxes. If the election is filed, the fund will report to its shareholders the per share amount of such foreign taxes withheld and the amount of foreign tax credit or deduction available for federal income tax purposes.

A fund may use equalization payments to satisfy its requirement to make distributions of net investment income and capital gain net income. Equalization payments occur when a fund allocates a portion of its net investment income and realized capital gain net income to redemptions of fund shares. These payments reduce the amount of taxable distributions paid to shareholders. The IRS has not issued any guidance concerning the methods used to allocate investment income and capital gain to redemptions of shares. If the IRS determines that a fund is using an improper method of allocation for these purposes, the fund may be liable for additional federal income tax.

This is a brief summary that relates to federal income taxation only. Shareholders should consult their tax advisor as to the application of federal, state, and local income tax laws to fund distributions.

See Appendix B for more information regarding state tax-exempt funds.

 

91


Table of Contents

 

Exchanges, Purchases and Sales

For tax purposes, an exchange is considered a sale and purchase, and may result in a gain or loss. A sale is a taxable transaction. If you sell shares for less than their cost, the difference is a capital loss. If you sell shares for more than their cost, the difference is a capital gain. Your gain may be short term (for shares held for one year or less) or long term (for shares held more than one year).

Capital gain of a non-corporate U.S. shareholder that is recognized in a taxable year beginning before January 1, 2011 is generally taxed at a maximum rate of 15% in respect of shares held for more than one year. Net capital gain of a corporate shareholder is taxed at the same rate as ordinary income. However, if shares on which a long-term capital gain distribution has been received are subsequently sold or redeemed and such shares have been held for six months or less (after taking into account certain hedging transactions), any loss realized will be treated as long-term capital loss to the extent that it does not exceed the long-term capital gain distribution.

A capital loss on a sale or redemption of a security in a nonqualified account may be disallowed for tax purposes if the same or a substantially identical security is purchased or acquired (including shares acquired through dividend reinvestment) within 30 days before or after the date of the loss transaction. This is called a wash sale. When a wash sale occurs, the loss is disallowed to the extent of shares repurchased, and the cost basis on the security acquired is increased by the amount of the loss that is disallowed. The loss is disallowed in a nonqualified account whether the purchase is in a nonqualified account or in an IRA or Roth IRA, however, an individual’s cost basis in an IRA or Roth IRA is not increased due to the wash sale rules. The wash sale rules apply only to capital losses. Sales of securities that result in capital gains are generally recognized when incurred.

If you buy Class A shares and within 91 days exchange into another fund, you may not include the sales charge in your calculation of tax gain or loss on the sale of the first fund you purchased. The sales charge may be included in the calculation of your tax gain or loss on a subsequent sale of the second fund you purchased.

For example

You purchase 100 shares of an equity fund having a public offering price of $10.00 per share. With a sales load of 5.75%, you pay $57.50 in sales load. With a NAV of $9.425 per share, the value of your investment is $942.50. Within 91 days of purchasing that fund, you decide to exchange out of that fund, now at a NAV of $11.00 per share, up from the original NAV of $9.425, and purchase a second fund, at a NAV of $15.00 per share. The value of your investment is now $1,100.00 ($11.00 x 100 shares). You cannot use the $57.50 paid as a sales load when calculating your tax gain or loss in the sale of the first fund shares. So instead of having a $100.00 gain ($1,100.00 – $1,000.00), you have a $157.50 gain ($1,100.00 – $942.50). You can include the $57.50 sales load in the calculation of your tax gain or loss when you sell shares in the second fund.

The following paragraphs provide information based on a fund’s investment category. You can find your fund’s investment category in Table 1.

For State Tax-Exempt Fixed Income and Tax-Exempt Fixed Income Funds, all distributions of net investment income during the fund’s fiscal year will have the same percentage designated as tax-exempt. This percentage is expected to be substantially the same as the percentage of tax-exempt income actually earned during any particular distribution period.

For Balanced, Equity, Funds-of-Funds, Taxable Money Market and Taxable Fixed Income Funds, if you have a nonqualified investment in a fund and you wish to move part or all of those shares to an IRA or qualified retirement account in the fund, you can do so without paying a sales charge. However, this type of exchange is considered a redemption of shares and may result in a gain or loss for tax purposes. See wash sale discussion above. In addition, this type of exchange may result in an excess contribution under IRA or qualified plan regulations if the amount exchanged exceeds annual contribution limitations. You should consult your tax advisor for further details about this complex subject.

Distributions

Dividends

Net investment income dividends (other than qualified dividend income) received and distributions from the excess of net short-term capital gains over net long-term capital losses should be treated as ordinary income for federal income tax purposes. Corporate shareholders are generally entitled to a deduction equal to 70% of that portion of a fund’s dividend that is attributable to dividends the fund received from domestic (U.S.) securities. If there is debt-financed portfolio stock, that is, bank financing is used to purchase long securities, the 70% dividends received deduction would be reduced by the average amount of portfolio indebtedness divided by the average adjusted basis in the stock. This does not impact the qualified dividend income available to individual shareholders. For the most recent fiscal period, net investment income dividends qualified for the corporate deduction are shown in the following table.

 

92


Table of Contents

 

Only certain QDI will be subject to the 15% and 0% (for lower-bracket taxpayers) tax rates for 2008-2010. QDI is dividends earned from domestic corporations and qualified foreign corporations. Qualified foreign corporations are corporations incorporated in a U.S. possession, corporations whose stock is readily tradable on an established U.S. securities market (ADRs), and certain other corporations eligible for relief under an income tax treaty with the U.S. that includes an exchange of information agreement. PFICs are excluded from this treatment. Holding periods for shares must also be met to be eligible for QDI treatment (more than 60 days for common stock and more than 90 days for certain preferred’s dividends).

Dividends declared in October, November or December, payable to shareholders of record on a specified date in such a month and paid in the following January will be treated as having been paid by a fund and received by each shareholder in December. Under this rule, therefore, shareholders may be taxed in one year on dividends or distributions actually received in January of the following year.

The QDI for individuals for the most recent fiscal period is shown in the table below. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 12. Corporate Deduction and Qualified Dividend Income

 

Fund

   Percent of dividends qualifying
for corporate deduction
    Qualified dividend income
for individuals
 

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

  

 

Columbia Income Builder Fund

     20.79     23.21

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     19.04        22.16   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     13.81        17.15   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     60.55        90.45   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     100.00        100.00   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     27.70        41.29   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     43.07        64.31   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     18.56        27.43   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     91.77        100.00   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     100.00        100.00   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     100.00        100.00   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

  

 

Columbia Equity Value

     100.00        100.00   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     5.22        20.29   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

  

 

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     100.00        100.00   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     35.61        42.61   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     45.41        50.54   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     47.80        54.77   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     53.80        62.70   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     60.75        70.54   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     61.11        70.71   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     60.82        70.52   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     61.81        71.38   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     67.54        77.42   

 

93


Table of Contents

Fund

  Percent of dividends qualifying
for corporate deduction
    Qualified dividend income
for individuals
 

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

  

 

Columbia High Yield Bond

    0     0

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

    0        0   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

    0        0   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

    100.00        100.00   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

    0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

  

 

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

    91.83        100.00   

RiverSource Real Estate

    0.35        7.02   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

  

 

Columbia Floating Rate

    0.06        0.06   

Columbia Income Opportunities

    0        0   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

    0        0   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

    0        0   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

    100.00        100.00   

Columbia Money Market

    0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

    100.00        100.00   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

    100.00        100.00   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

  

 

Columbia Diversified Bond

    0        0   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

    0        0   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

    0        0   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

    0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

  

 

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

    100.00        100.00   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

    100.00        100.00   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

    46.66        47.51   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

    100.00        100.00   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

    85.51        94.62   

RiverSource Balanced

    58.23        67.65   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

    0.31        1.00   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

    0        0   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

    0        0   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

    0        0   

Seligman National Municipal

    0        0   

Seligman New York Municipal

    0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

    53.63        87.73   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

    50.39        100.00   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

    48.74        100.00   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

    43.70        100.00   

Seligman TargETFund Core

    50.44        63.90   

 

94


Table of Contents

Fund

  Percent of dividends qualifying
for corporate deduction
    Qualified dividend income
for individuals
 

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

  

 

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

    0     0

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

    0        53.84   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

    0        0   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

    0.27        81.67   

Columbia European Equity

    0        100.00   

Columbia Frontier

    0        0   

Columbia Global Bond

    0        0   

Columbia Global Equity

    77.49        100.00   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

    0        0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

    2.08        100.00   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

    0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

    0.25        100.00   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

    2.04        100.00   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

    0        0   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

    29.74        100.00   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

    0        100.00   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

  

 

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

    0        0   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

    0        0   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

    0        0   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

    0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

  

 

Columbia Government Money Market

    0        0   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

    100.00        100.00   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

    0        100.00   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

    0        0   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

    0        2.58   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

    0        2.09   

Seligman Capital

    0        0   

Seligman Growth

    100.00        100.00   

Capital Gains Distributions

Capital gain distributions, if any, received by shareholders (in cash or invested in additional shares) should be treated as long-term capital gains regardless of how long shareholders owned their shares. Short-term capital gains earned by a fund are paid to shareholders as part of their ordinary income dividend and are taxable as ordinary income. Special rates on capital gains may apply to sales of precious metals, if any, owned directly by a fund and to investments in REITs.

Individual shareholders will be subject to federal income tax on distributions of net capital gains generally at a maximum rate of 15% if designated as derived from a fund’s capital gains from property held for more than one year and recognized in the taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011. Net capital gain of a corporate shareholder is taxed at the same rate as ordinary income. Such distributions are not eligible for the dividends received deduction allowed to corporate shareholders. Shareholders receiving distributions in the form of additional shares issued by a fund will generally be treated for federal income tax purposes as having received a distribution in an amount equal to the cash that could have been elected to be received instead of the additional shares.

 

95


Table of Contents

 

Under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (the Code), gains or losses attributable to fluctuations in exchange rates that occur between the time a fund accrues interest or other receivables, or accrues expenses or other liabilities denominated in a foreign currency and the time the fund actually collects such receivables or pays such liabilities generally are treated as ordinary income or ordinary loss. Similarly, gains or losses on disposition of debt securities denominated in a foreign currency attributable to fluctuations in the value of the foreign currency between the date of acquisition of the security and the date of disposition may be treated as ordinary or capital gains or losses. These gains or losses, referred to under the Code as “section 988” gains or losses, may increase or decrease the amount of a fund’s investment company taxable income to be distributed to its shareholders as ordinary income.

Return of Capital

If a mutual fund is the holder of record of any share of stock on the record date for any dividend payable with respect to the stock, the dividend will be included in gross income by the fund as of the later of (1) the date the share became ex-dividend or (2) the date the fund acquired the share. Because the dividends on some foreign equity investments may be received some time after the stock goes ex-dividend, and in certain rare cases may never be received by the fund, this rule may cause a fund to pay income to its shareholders that it has not actually received. To the extent that the dividend is never received, the fund will take a loss at the time that a determination is made that the dividend will not be received.

If a fund’s distributions exceed its current and accumulated earnings and profits, that portion of the fund’s distributions will be treated as a return of capital to its shareholders. A return of capital is a return of a portion of the shareholder’s original investment. A return of capital will generally not be taxable, however, any amounts received in excess of a shareholder’s tax basis are treated as capital gain. Forms 1099 will be sent to shareholders to report any return of capital.

Withholding

Unless a shareholder provides a certified taxpayer identification number (social security number for individuals) on the account application or other document and certifies that the shareholder is not subject to backup withholding, the fund is required to withhold and remit to the IRS 28% backup withholding on taxable and exempt-interest dividends and redemptions. Shareholders should be aware that, under regulations promulgated by the IRS, a fund may be fined for each account for which a certified taxpayer identification number (social security number for individuals) is not provided.

Taxation of a shareholder who, as to the United States, is a nonresident alien individual, foreign trust or estate, foreign corporation, or foreign partnership (“foreign shareholder”) depends on whether the income from the fund is “effectively connected” with a U.S. trade or business carried on by such shareholder. If the income from the fund is not effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business carried on by a foreign shareholder, ordinary income and qualified dividends paid to such foreign shareholders generally will be subject to a 30% U.S. withholding tax under existing provisions of the Internal Revenue Code applicable to foreign individuals and entities unless a reduced rate of withholding or a withholding exemption is provided under applicable treaty or law. Nonresident shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisers concerning the applicability of the U.S. withholding tax.

If the income from the fund is effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business carried on by a foreign shareholder, then ordinary income dividends, qualified dividends, capital gain dividends, undistributed capital gains credited to such shareholder and any gains realized upon the sale of shares of the fund will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at the graduated rates applicable to U.S. citizens or domestic corporations. In the case of foreign non-corporate shareholders, the fund may be required to backup withhold U.S. federal income tax on distributions that are otherwise exempt from withholding tax (or taxable at a reduced treaty rate) unless such shareholders furnish the fund with proper documentation related to their foreign status.

The tax consequences to a foreign shareholder entitled to claim the benefits of an applicable tax treaty may be different from those described herein. Foreign shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisers with respect to the particular tax consequences to them of an investment in the fund, the procedure for claiming the benefit of a lower treaty rate and the applicability of foreign taxes.

Seligman TargETFunds. Each of Seligman TargETFund 2045, Seligman TargETFund 2035, Seligman TargETFund 2025 and Seligman TargETFund 2015 (Target Date Funds) will automatically be combined with Seligman TargETFund Core during their respective target year. The investment manager expects each of these combinations to be effected as an acquisition of the assets and liabilities of the applicable Target Date Fund in exchange for shares of TargETFund Core at net asset value, with the shares of TargETFund Core then distributed to shareholders of the applicable Target Date Fund. Based on current tax rules, the investment manager expects the combination to be effected in a non-taxable transaction. Changes in such tax rules or applicable law or other developments could negatively impact the combination of the Target Date Funds with Seligman TargETFund Core.

Due to the impossibility of predicting whether changes in law or other developments may impact the fairness or overall desirability of the combination of any two funds ten or more years in the future, the Board of the Seligman TargETFunds

 

96


Table of Contents

will evaluate each combination in the year it is scheduled to occur under the standards of Rule 17a-8 under the 1940 Act and general principles of fairness, and may approve modifications to the methodology or terminate the combination if it determines that doing so would be in the best interests of shareholders. Any modifications to the manner of combining funds will be presented to shareholders for approval if such approval is required under applicable law.

Service Providers

INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT SERVICES

Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC) is the investment manager for each fund. Under the Investment Management Services Agreements, the investment manager, subject to the policies set by the Board, provides investment management services to the funds.

For Seligman funds, Columbia Management serves as the investment manager effective Nov. 7, 2008, with the completion of the acquisition of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated by the investment manager and with shareholders having previously approved a new investment management services agreement between the funds and the investment manager.

For its services, the investment manager is paid a monthly fee based on the following schedule. Each class of a fund pays its proportionate share of the fee. The fee is calculated for each calendar day on the basis of net assets as of the close of the preceding day.

Table 13. Investment Management Services Agreement Fee Schedule

 

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   First $ 0.25         0.950   0.950%
   Next $ 0.25         0.930  
   Next $ 0.50         0.910  
   Over $ 1.0         0.890  

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   First $ 1.0         0.890   0.890%
   Next $ 1.0         0.865  
   Next $ 1.0         0.840  
   Next $ 3.0         0.815  
   Next $ 1.5         0.790  
   Next $ 1.5         0.775  
   Next $ 1.0         0.770  
   Next $ 5.0         0.760  
   Next $ 5.0         0.750  
   Next $ 4.0         0.740  
   Next $ 26.0         0.720  
   Over $ 50.0         0.700  

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

   First $ 1.0         0.410   0.410%
   Next $ 1.0         0.385  
   Next $ 1.0         0.360  
   Next $ 3.0         0.335  
   Next $ 1.5         0.310  
   Next $ 2.5         0.300  
   Next $ 5.0         0.290  
   Next $ 9.0         0.280  
   Next $ 26.0         0.260  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

 

97


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

   First $ 0.25         0.800   Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan – 0.800%

Columbia European Equity

   Next $ 0.25         0.775   Columbia European Equity – 0.800%

Columbia Global Equity

   Next $ 0.25         0.750   Columbia Global Equity – 0.788%

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

   Next $ 0.25         0.725   RiverSource Disciplined International Equity – 0.788%

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   Next $ 1.0         0.700   Threadneedle Global Equity Income – 0.800%

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   Next $ 5.5         0.675   Threadneedle International Opportunity – 0.790%
   Next $ 2.5         0.660  
   Next $ 5.0         0.645  
   Next $ 5.0         0.635  
   Next $ 4.0         0.610  
   Next $ 26.0         0.600  
   Over $ 50.0         0.570  

Columbia Diversified Bond

   First $ 1.0         0.480   Columbia Diversified Bond – 0.442%

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

   Next $ 1.0         0.455   Columbia Limited Duration Credit – 0.480%
   Next $ 1.0         0.430  
   Next $ 3.0         0.405  
   Next $ 1.5         0.380  
   Next $ 1.5         0.365  
   Next $ 1.0         0.360  
   Next $ 5.0         0.350  
   Next $ 5.0         0.340  
   Next $ 4.0         0.330  
   Next $ 26.0         0.310  
   Over $ 50.0         0.290  

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   First $ 1.0         0.600   Columbia Diversified Equity Income – 0.558%

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

   Next $ 1.0         0.575   Columbia Large Core Quantitative – 0.565%

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

   Next $ 1.0         0.550   Columbia Large Growth Quantitative – 0.600%

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

   Next $ 3.0         0.525   Columbia Large Value Quantitative – 0.600%
   Next $ 1.5         0.500  
   Next $ 2.5         0.485  
   Next $ 5.0         0.470  
   Next $ 5.0         0.450  
   Next $ 4.0         0.425  
   Next $ 26.0         0.400  
   Over $ 50.0         0.375  

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   First $ 0.50         0.610   0.542%
   Next $ 0.50         0.585  
   Next $ 1.0         0.560  
   Next $ 1.0         0.535  
   Next $ 3.0         0.510  
   Next $ 4.0         0.480  
   Next $ 5.0         0.470  
   Next $ 5.0         0.450  
   Next $ 4.0         0.425  
   Next $ 26.0         0.400  
   Over $ 50.0         0.375  

 

98


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

   First $ 0.25         0.720   Columbia Emerging Markets Bond – 0.719%

Columbia Global Bond

   Next $ 0.25         0.695   Columbia Global Bond – 0.699%
   Next $ 0.25         0.670  
   Next $ 0.25         0.645  
   Next $ 6.5         0.620  
   Next $ 2.5         0.605  
   Next $ 5.0         0.590  
   Next $ 5.0         0.580  
   Next $ 4.0         0.560  
   Next $ 26.0         0.540  
   Over $ 50.0         0.520  

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   First $ 0.25         1.100   1.086%
   Next $ 0.25         1.080  
   Next $ 0.25         1.060  
   Next $ 0.25         1.040  
   Next $ 1.0         1.020  
   Next $ 5.5         1.000  
   Next $ 2.5         0.985  
   Next $ 5.0         0.970  
   Net   $ 5.0         0.960  
   Next $ 4.0         0.935  
   Next $ 26.0         0.920  
   Over $ 50.0         0.900  

Columbia Equity Value

   First $ 0.50         0.530   0.521%
   Next $ 0.50         0.505  
   Next $ 1.0         0.480  
   Next $ 1.0         0.455  
   Next $ 3.0         0.430  
   Over $ 6.0         0.400  

Columbia Floating Rate

   First $ 1.0         0.610   0.610%

Columbia Income Opportunities

   Next $ 1.0         0.585  
   Next $ 1.0         0.560  
   Next $ 3.0         0.535  
   Next $ 1.5         0.510  
   Next $ 1.5         0.495  
   Next $ 1.0         0.470  
   Next $ 5.0         0.455  
   Next $ 5.0         0.445  
   Next $ 4.0         0.420  
   Next $ 26.0         0.405  
   Over $ 50.0         0.380  

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

   First $ 0.25         1.050   1.050%
   Next $ 0.25         1.030  
   Next $ 0.50         1.010  
   Next $ 1.0         0.990  

 

99


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Columbia Government Money Market(a)

   First $ 1.0         0.330   Columbia Government Money Market – 0.330%

Columbia Money Market

   Next $ 0.5         0.313   Columbia Money Market – 0.306%
   Next $ 0.5         0.295  
   Next $ 0.5         0.278  
   Next $ 2.5         0.260  
   Next $ 1.0         0.240  
   Next $ 1.5         0.220  
   Next $ 1.5         0.215  
   Next $ 1.0         0.190  
   Next $ 5.0         0.180  
   Next $ 5.0         0.170  
   Next $ 4.0         0.160  
   Over $ 24.0         0.150  

Columbia High Yield Bond

   First $ 1.0         0.590   0.580%
   Next $ 1.0         0.565  
   Next $ 1.0         0.540  
   Next $ 3.0         0.515  
   Next $ 1.5         0.490  
   Next $ 1.5         0.475  
   Next $ 1.0         0.450  
   Next $ 5.0         0.435  
   Next $ 5.0         0.425  
   Next $ 4.0         0.400  
   Next $ 26.0         0.385  
   Over $ 50.0         0.360  

Columbia Income Builder Fund

     N/A         N/A      N/A

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

       

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

       

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

       

 

100


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

   First $ 1.0         0.440   0.440%
   Next $ 1.0         0.415  
   Next $ 1.0         0.390  
   Next $ 3.0         0.365  
   Next $ 1.5         0.340  
   Next $ 1.5         0.325  
   Next $ 1.0         0.320  
   Next $ 5.0         0.310  
   Next $ 5.0         0.300  
   Next $ 4.0         0.290  
   Next $ 26.0         0.270  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

   First $ 1.0         0.700   0.700%

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

   Next $ 1.0         0.675  
   Next $ 1.0         0.650  
   Next $ 3.0         0.625  
   Next $ 1.5         0.600  
   Next $ 2.5         0.575  
   Next $ 5.0         0.550  
   Next $ 9.0         0.525  
   Next $ 26.0         0.500  
   Over $ 50.0         0.475  

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

   First $ 1.0         0.700   0.686%
   Next $ 1.0         0.675  
   Next $ 1.0         0.650  
   Next $ 3.0         0.625  
   Next $ 1.5         0.600  
   Next $ 2.5         0.575  
   Next $ 5.0         0.550  
   Next $ 9.0         0.525  
   Next $ 26.0         0.500  
   Over $ 50.0         0.475  

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

   First $ 0.25         0.410   Columbia Minnesota – 0.403%

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

   Next $ 0.25         0.385   RiverSource California – 0.410%

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

   Next $ 0.25         0.360   RiverSource New York – 0.410%
   Next $ 0.25         0.345  
   Next $ 6.5         0.320  
   Next $ 2.5         0.310  
   Next $ 5.0         0.300  
   Next $ 9.0         0.290  
   Next $ 26.0         0.270  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   First $ 0.25         0.900   0.863%
   Next $ 0.25         0.875  
   Next $ 0.25         0.850  
   Next $ 0.25         0.825  
   Next $ 1.0         0.800  
   Over $ 2.0         0.775  

 

101


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   First $ 0.25         0.970   0.960%
   Next $ 0.25         0.945  
   Next $ 0.25         0.920  
   Next $ 0.25         0.895  
   Over $ 1.0         0.870  

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

   First $ 1.0         0.650   0.650%
   Next $ 1.0         0.600  
   Next $ 4.0         0.550  
   Over $ 6.0         0.500  

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value(b)

   First $ 0.5         0.755   0.755%
   Next $ 0.5         0.660  
   Over $ 1.0         0.565  

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value(c)

   First $ 0.5         0.935   0.935%
   Next $ 0.5         0.840  
   Over $ 1.0         0.745  

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information(d)

   First $ 3.0         0.855   0.849%
   Next $ 3.0         0.825  
   Over $ 6.0         0.725  

Columbia Seligman Global Technology(e)

   First $ 2.0         0.950   0.950%
   Next $ 2.0         0.910  
   Over $ 4.0         0.870  

Columbia Strategic Allocation

   First $ 1.0         0.570   0.564%
   Next $ 1.0         0.545  
   Next $ 1.0         0.520  
   Next $ 3.0         0.495  
   Next $ 1.5         0.470  
   Next $ 2.5         0.450  
   Next $ 5.0         0.430  
   Next $ 9.0         0.410  
   Over $ 24.0         0.390  

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

   First $ 1.0         0.480   0.480%
   Next $ 1.0         0.455  
   Next $ 1.0         0.430  
   Next $ 3.0         0.405  
   Next $ 1.5         0.380  
   Next $ 1.5         0.365  
   Next $ 1.0         0.360  
   Next $ 5.0         0.350  
   Next $ 5.0         0.340  
   Next $ 4.0         0.330  
   Next $ 26.0         0.310  
   Over $ 50.0         0.290  

RiverSource Balanced

   First $ 1.0         0.530   0.530%
   Next $ 1.0         0.505  
   Next $ 1.0         0.480  
   Next $ 3.0         0.455  
   Next $ 1.5         0.430  
   Next $ 2.5         0.410  
   Next $ 5.0         0.390  
   Next $ 9.0         0.370  
   Over $ 24.0         0.350  

 

102


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

   First $ 0.25         0.850   0.850%
   Next $ 0.25         0.825  
   Next $ 0.25         0.800  
   Next $ 0.25         0.775  
   Next $ 1.0         0.750  
   Over $ 2.0         0.725  

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

   First $ 1.0         0.390   0.390%
   Next $ 1.0         0.365  
   Next $ 1.0         0.340  
   Next $ 3.0         0.315  
   Next $ 1.5         0.290  
   Next $ 2.5         0.280  
   Next $ 5.0         0.270  
   Next $ 35.0         0.260  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate(f)

     All         0.915   0.915%

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate(g)

     All         0.855   0.855%

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   First $ 0.50         0.730   0.728%
   Next $ 0.50         0.705  
   Next $ 1.0         0.680  
   Next $ 1.0         0.655  
   Next $ 3.0         0.630  
   Over $ 6.0         0.600  

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   First $ 0.25         1.000   0.990%
   Next $ 0.25         0.975  
   Next $ 0.25         0.950  
   Next $ 0.25         0.925  
   Next $ 1.0         0.900  
   Over $ 2.0         0.875  

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   First $ 0.25         1.120   1.120%
   Next $ 0.25         1.095  
   Next $ 0.25         1.070  
   Next $ 0.25         1.045  
   Next $ 1.0         1.020  
   Over $ 2.0         0.995  

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

   First $ 0.25         0.800   0.800%
   Next $ 0.25         0.775  
   Next $ 0.25         0.750  
   Next $ 0.25         0.725  
   Next $ 1.0         0.700  
   Over $ 2.0         0.675  

RiverSource Real Estate

   First $ 1.0         0.840   0.840%
   Next $ 1.0         0.815  
   Next $ 1.0         0.790  
   Next $ 3.0         0.765  
   Next $ 6.0         0.740  
   Next $ 12.0         0.730  
   Over $ 24.0         0.720  

 

103


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

   First $ 1.0         0.220   0.220%
   Next $ 1.0         0.210  
   Next $ 1.0         0.200  
   Next $ 4.5         0.190  
   Next $ 2.5         0.180  
   Next $ 5.0         0.170  
   Next $ 9.0         0.160  
   Next $ 26.0         0.140  
   Over $ 50.0         0.120  

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

   First $ 1.0         0.480   0.480%
   Next $ 1.0         0.455  
   Next $ 1.0         0.430  
   Next $ 3.0         0.405  
   Next $ 1.5         0.380  
   Next $ 1.5         0.365  
   Next $ 1.0         0.340  
   Next $ 5.0         0.325  
   Next $ 5.0         0.315  
   Next $ 4.0         0.290  
   Next $ 26.0         0.275  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

RiverSource Small Company Index

   First $ 0.25         0.360   0.357%
   Next $ 0.25         0.350  
   Next $ 0.25         0.340  
   Next $ 0.25         0.330  
   Next $ 6.5         0.320  
   Next $ 7.5         0.300  
   Next $ 9.0         0.280  
   Next $ 26.0         0.260  
   Over $ 50.0         0.240  

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

   First $ 0.25         0.550   0.546%
   Next $ 0.25         0.525  
   Next $ 0.25         0.500  
   Over $ 0.75         0.475  

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

   First $ 1.0         0.470   0.453%
   Next $ 1.0         0.445  
   Next $ 1.0         0.420  
   Next $ 3.0         0.395  
   Next $ 1.5         0.370  
   Next $ 2.5         0.360  
   Next $ 5.0         0.350  
   Next $ 9.0         0.340  
   Next $ 26.0         0.320  
   Over $ 50.0         0.300  

 

104


Table of Contents

Fund

   Assets
(billions)
     Annual rate at
each asset level
   

Daily rate on
last day of most
recent fiscal period

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield(h)

   First $ 0.25         0.410   0.410%

Seligman California Municipal Quality(h)

   Next $ 0.25         0.385  

Seligman Minnesota Municipal(h)

   Next $ 0.25         0.360  

Seligman New York Municipal(h)

   Next $ 0.25         0.345  
   Next $ 6.5         0.320  
   Next $ 2.5         0.310  
   Next $ 5.0         0.300  
   Next $ 9.0         0.290  
   Next $ 26.0         0.270  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

Seligman Capital(i)

   First $ 1.0         0.805   0.805%
   Next $ 1.0         0.765  
   Over $ 2.0         0.715  

Seligman Frontier(j)

   First $ 0.75         0.885   0.885%
   Over $ 0.75         0.790  

Seligman Growth(k)

   First $ 1.0         0.655   0.639%
   Next $ 1.0         0.615  
   Over $ 2.0         0.565  

Seligman National Municipal(l)

   First $ 1.0         0.410   0.410%
   Next $ 1.0         0.385  
   Next $ 1.0         0.360  
   Next $ 3.0         0.335  
   Next $ 1.5         0.310  
   Next $ 2.5         0.300  
   Next $ 5.0         0.290  
   Next $ 9.0         0.280  
   Next $ 26.0         0.260  
   Over $ 50.0         0.250  

Seligman TargETFund 2015

   First $ 0.5         0.455   0.455%

Seligman TargETFund 2025

   Next $ 0.5         0.410  

Seligman TargETFund 2035

   Over $ 1.0         0.365  

Seligman TargETFund 2045

       

Seligman TargETFund Core

       

 

(a) Prior to June 15, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.40% of the fund’s average daily net assets.
(b) Prior to June 29, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.80% of the fund’s average daily net assets.
(c) Prior to June 29, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 1.00% of the fund’s average daily net assets.
(d) Prior to June 29, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.90% on the first $3.0 billion of the fund’s average daily net assets, 0.85% on the next $3.0 billion and 0.75% thereafter.
(e) Prior to June 15, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 1.00% of average daily net assets on the first $2 billion of net assets, 0.95% of average daily net assets on the next $2 billion and 0.90% of average daily net assets in excess of $4 billion.
(f) Prior to June 15, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.98% of the fund’s average daily net assets.
(g) Prior to June 15, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.90% of the fund’s average daily net assets.
(h) Prior to June 15, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.50% of the fund’s average daily net assets.
(i) Prior to June 29, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.85% on the first $1.0 billion of the fund’s average daily net assets, 0.80% on the next $1.0 billion and 0.75% thereafter.
(j) Prior to June 29, 2009, the investment manager received a fee equal to 0.95% per annum of the fund’s average daily net assets on the first $750 million of net assets and 0.85% per annum of the fund’s average daily net assets in excess of $750 million.
(k) Prior to June 29, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.70% on the first $1.0 billion of the fund’s average daily net assets, 0.65% on the next $1.0 billion and 0.60% thereafter.
(l) Prior to Aug. 31, 2009, the investment manager received an annual fee equal to 0.50% of the fund’s average daily net assets.

Under the agreement, a fund also pays taxes, brokerage commissions and nonadvisory expenses, which include custodian fees and charges; fidelity bond premiums; certain legal fees; registration fees for shares; consultants’ fees; compensation of Board members, officers and employees not employed by the investment manager or its affiliates; corporate filing fees;

 

105


Table of Contents

organizational expenses; expenses incurred in connection with lending securities; interest and fee expense related to a fund’s participation in inverse floater structures; and expenses properly payable by a fund, approved by the Board.

For Equity and Balanced Funds, except for RiverSource S&P 500 Index, RiverSource Small Company Index and the Seligman funds, before the fee based on the asset charge is paid, it is adjusted for the fund’s investment performance relative to a Performance Incentive Adjustment Index (PIA Index) as shown in the table below. The adjustment increased or decreased the fee for the last fiscal period as shown in the following table. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 14. PIA Indexes

 

Fund

  

PIA Index

   Fee Increase  or
(Decrease)
 

Fiscal year ending March 31

     

Columbia Equity Value

   Lipper Large-Cap Value Funds Index    $ (84,713

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

   Lipper Precious Metals Funds Index      5,214   

Fiscal year ending April 30

     

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   Russell 3000 Index      (16,065

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

   S&P 500 Index      N/A (a) 

Fiscal year ending May 31

     

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Index      353,598   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Index      135,795   

Fiscal year ending June 30

     

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   Lipper Equity Income Funds Index      902,715   

RiverSource Real Estate

   Lipper Real Estate Funds Index      52,237   

Fiscal year ending July 31

     

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

   Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Index      (789,031

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

   Lipper Mid-Cap Core Funds Index      (126,252

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

   Lipper Small-Cap Value Funds Index      (56,412

Fiscal year ending September 30

     

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   Lipper Equity Income Funds Index      (5,590,723

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

   Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Index      (9,448

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

   Lipper Large-Cap Value Funds Index      (33,219

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

   Lipper Mid-Cap Value Funds Index      (2,112,990

Columbia Strategic Allocation

   Lipper Flexible Portfolio Funds Index      (556,345

RiverSource Balanced

   Lipper Balanced Funds Index      (474,081

Fiscal year ending October 31

     

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

   MSCI All Country Asia Pacific Ex-Japan Index      N/A (b) 

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   Lipper Emerging Markets Funds Index      (54,050

Columbia European Equity

   Lipper European Funds Index      97,462   

Columbia Global Equity

   Lipper Global Funds Index      (446,000

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

   MSCI All Country World Index      N/A (c) 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   Lipper International Multi-Cap Value Funds Index      (1,510,778

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

   Lipper International Large-Cap Core Funds Index      (629,082

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   Lipper International Multi-Cap Growth Funds Index      (267,871

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   Lipper International Small-Cap Funds Index      (48,195

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   MSCI All Country World Index      10,034   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   Lipper International Large-Cap Core Funds Index      286,033   

Fiscal year ending November 30

     

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

   Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Index      469,963   

 

(a) The first performance incentive adjustment will be made on March 1, 2011. See section titled “Transaction Period” below.
(b) The first performance incentive adjustment will be made Feb. 1, 2010. See section titled “Transition Period” below.

 

106


Table of Contents

 

(c) The first performance incentive adjustment will be made on Aug. 1, 2010. See section titled “Transition Period” below.

For all funds noted in Table 14 EXCEPT Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity, Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure, and Columbia Global Extended Alpha:

The adjustment will be determined monthly by measuring the percentage difference over a rolling 12-month period (subject to earlier determination based on the Transition Period, as set forth below) between the annualized performance of one Class A share of the fund and the annualized performance of the PIA Index (“performance difference”). The performance difference is then used to determine the adjustment rate. The adjustment rate, computed to five decimal places, is determined in accordance with the following table and is applied against average daily net assets for the applicable rolling 12-month period or Transition Period, and divided by 12 to obtain the fee reflecting the performance fee adjustment for that month. The table is organized by fund category. You can find your fund’s category in Table 1.

Table 15A. Performance Incentive Adjustment Calculation

 

Equity Funds

   Balanced Funds

Performance
Difference

  

Adjustment Rate

   Performance
Difference
  

Adjustment Rate

0.00% – 0.50%

   0    0.00% – 0.50%    0

0.50% – 1.00%

   6 basis points times the performance difference over 0.50%, times 100 (maximum of 3 basis points if a 1% performance difference)    0.50% – 1.00%    6 basis points times the performance difference over 0.50%, times 100 (maximum of 3 basis points if a 1% performance difference)

1.00% – 2.00%

   3 basis points, plus 3 basis points times the performance difference over 1.00%, times 100 (maximum 6 basis points if a 2% performance difference)    1.00% – 2.00%    3 basis points, plus 3 basis points times the performance difference over 1.00%, times 100 (maximum 6 basis points if a 2% performance difference)

2.00% – 4.00%

   6 basis points, plus 2 basis points times the performance difference over 2.00%, times 100 (maximum 10 basis points if a 4% performance difference)    2.00% – 3.00%    6 basis points, plus 2 basis points times the performance difference over 2.00%, times 100 (maximum 8 basis points if a 3% performance difference)

4.00% – 6.00%

   10 basis points, plus 1 basis point times the performance difference over 4.00%, times 100 (maximum 12 basis points if a 6% performance difference)    3.00% or more    8 basis points

6.00% or more

   12 basis points    N/A   

For example, if the performance difference for an Equity Fund is 2.38%, the adjustment rate is 0.000676 (0.0006 [6 basis points] plus 0.0038 [the 0.38% performance difference over 2.00%] x 0.0002 [2 basis points] x 100 (0.000076)). Rounded to five decimal places, the adjustment rate is 0.00068. The maximum adjustment rate for the fund is 0.0012 per year. Where the fund’s Class A performance exceeds that of the PIA Index, the fee paid to the investment manager will increase. Where the performance of the PIA Index exceeds the performance of the fund’s Class A shares, the fee paid to the investment manager will decrease. The 12-month comparison period rolls over with each succeeding month, so that it always equals 12 months, ending with the month for which the performance adjustment is being computed.

Transition Period

The performance incentive adjustment will not be calculated for the first 6 months from the inception of the fund. After 6 full calendar months, the performance fee adjustment will be determined using the average assets and performance difference over the first 6 full calendar months, and the adjustment rate will be applied in full. Each successive month an additional calendar month will be added to the performance adjustment computation. After 12 full calendar months, the full rolling 12-month period will take affect.

Change in Index

If the PIA Index ceases to be published for a period of more than 90 days, changes in any material respect, otherwise becomes impracticable or, at the discretion of the Board, is no longer appropriate to use for purposes of a performance incentive adjustment, for example, if Lipper reclassifies the fund from one peer group to another, the Board may take action it deems appropriate and in the best interests of shareholders, including: (1) discontinuance of the performance incentive

 

107


Table of Contents

adjustment until such time as it approves a substitute index; or (2) adoption of a methodology to transition to a substitute index it has approved.

In the case of a change in the PIA Index, a fund’s performance will be compared to a 12-month blended index return that reflects the performance of the current index for the portion of the 12-month performance measurement period beginning the effective date of the current index and the performance of the prior index for the remainder of the measurement period. At the conclusion of the transition period, the performance of the prior index will be eliminated from the performance incentive adjustment calculation, and the calculation will include only the performance of the current index.

For Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity, Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure, and Columbia Global Extended Alpha:

The adjustment will be determined monthly by measuring the percentage difference over a rolling 36-month period (subject to earlier determination based on the Transition Period, as set forth below) between the annualized performance of one Class A share of the fund and the annualized performance of the PIA Index (“performance difference”). The performance difference will then be used to determine the adjustment rate. The adjustment rate, computed to five decimal places, is determined in accordance with the following table and is applied against average daily net assets for the applicable rolling 36-month period or Transition Period, and divided by 12 to obtain the fee reflecting the performance fee adjustment for that month.

Table 15B. Performance Incentive Adjustment Calculation

 

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

  

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

Performance
Difference

  

Adjustment Rate

  

Performance
Difference

  

Adjustment Rate

0.00% – 0.50%    0    0.00% – 1.00%    0
0.50% – 1.00%    6 basis points times the performance difference over 0.50%, times 100 (maximum of 3 basis points if a 1% performance difference)    1.00% – 6.00%    10 basis points times the performance difference over 1.00%, times 100 (maximum 50 basis points if a 6% performance difference)
1.00% – 2.00%    3 basis points, plus 3 basis points times the performance difference over 1.00%, times 100 (maximum 6 basis points if a 2% performance difference)    6.00% or more    50 basis points
2.00% – 4.00%    6 basis points, plus 2 basis points times the performance difference over 2.00%, times 100 (maximum 10 basis points if a 4% performance difference)    N/A   
4.00% – 6.00%    10 basis points, plus 1 basis point times the performance difference over 4.00%, times 100 (maximum 12 basis points if a 6% performance difference)    N/A   
6.00% or more    12 basis points    N/A   

For example, if the performance difference for Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity is 2.38%, the adjustment rate is 0.00138 [the 1.38% performance difference over 1.00%] x 0.0010 [10 basis points] x 100. Rounded to five decimal places, the adjustment rate is 0.00138. This adjustment rate of 0.00138 is then applied against the average daily net assets for the applicable rolling 36-month or Transition Period, and divided by 12, which provides the performance adjustment fee for that month. Where the fund’s Class A performance exceeds that of the PIA Index for the applicable rolling 36-month period or Transition Period, the fee paid to the investment manager will increase by the adjustment rate. Where the performance of the PIA Index exceeds the performance of the fund’s Class A shares for the applicable rolling 36-month period or Transition Period, the fee paid to the Investment Manager will decrease by the adjustment rate.

The 36-month comparison period rolls over with each succeeding month, so that it always equals 36 months, ending with the month for which the performance adjustment is being computed.

Transition Period

The performance incentive adjustment will not be calculated for the first 24 months from the inception of the fund. After 24 full calendar months, the performance fee adjustment will be determined using the average assets and Performance

 

108


Table of Contents

Difference over the first 24 full calendar months, and the Adjustment Rate will be applied in full. Each successive month an additional calendar month will be added to the performance adjustment computation. After 36 full calendar months, the full rolling 36-month period will take affect.

Change in Index

If the PIA Index ceases to be published for a period of more than 90 days, changes in any material respect, otherwise becomes impracticable or, at the discretion of the Board, is no longer appropriate to use for purposes of a performance incentive adjustment, the Board may take action it deems appropriate and in the best interests of shareholders, including: (1) discontinuance of the performance incentive adjustment until such time as it approves a substitute index, or (2) adoption of a methodology to transition to a substitute index it has approved.

In the case of a change the PIA Index, a fund’s performance will be compared to a 36-month blended index return that reflects the performance of the current index for the portion of the 36-month performance measurement period beginning the effective date of the current index and the performance of the prior index for the remainder of the measurement period. At the conclusion of the transition period, the performance of the prior index will be eliminated from the performance incentive adjustment calculation, and the calculation will include only the performance of the current index.

The table below shows the total management fees paid by each fund for the last three fiscal periods as well as nonadvisory expenses, net of earnings credits, waivers and expenses reimbursed by the investment manager and its affiliates. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 16. Management Fees and Nonadvisory Expenses

 

     Management Fees     Nonadvisory expenses  

Fund

   2010      2009     2008     2010     2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

             

Columbia Income Builder Fund

     N/A         N/A        N/A      $ 101,055      $ 139,640      $ 103,636 (a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     N/A         N/A        N/A        109,874        175,842        129,062 (a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     N/A         N/A        N/A        112,467        118,255        134,546 (a) 

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     N/A         N/A        N/A        107,162        199,501        168,942   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     N/A         N/A        N/A        151,416        146,492        96,147   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     N/A         N/A        N/A        272,479        278,861        247,980   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     N/A         N/A        N/A        290,338        299,503        247,472   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     N/A         N/A        N/A        164,289        170,774        117,533   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     N/A         N/A        N/A        28,299        149,589        173,675   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

   $ 255,644       $ 371,178      $ 579,548        (29,594     (194,370     (254,777

RiverSource Small Company Index

     1,306,919         1,990,095        3,292,392        (1,051,278     (1,171,627     (1,007,306

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

             

Columbia Equity Value

     3,406,527         4,340,117        6,797,853        309,679        343,552        413,170   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     1,112,166         824,176        956,280        144,675        242,615        175,405   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

             

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   $ 360,835         368,969        159,311 (b)    $ 31,738        34,475        21,297 (b) 

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     2,163,593         45,652 (c)      N/A        232,888        18,717 (c)      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     N/A         N/A        N/A        (2,671     (4,254     41   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     N/A         N/A        N/A        (7,079     (7,894     310   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     N/A         N/A        N/A        (7,779     (9,956     745   

 

109


Table of Contents
     Management Fees      Nonadvisory expenses  

Fund

   2010      2009      2008      2010     2009     2008  

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     N/A         N/A         N/A       $ (11,346   $ (12,026   $ 332   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     N/A         N/A         N/A         (9,157     (9,748     431   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     N/A         N/A         N/A         (8,136     (7,948     487   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     N/A         N/A         N/A         (7,439     (6,946     (796

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     N/A         N/A         N/A         (7,533     (6,418     (2,131

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

               

Columbia High Yield Bond

   $ 9,691,900       $ 6,353,707       $ 9,610,610         (400,525     (748,008     665,785   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     3,968,159         3,098,591         6,511,571         (684,318     (963,886     (972,781

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     1,247,010         1,731,277         1,958,404         (256,078     (327,855     (389,262

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     4,305,601         4,416,792         7,668,633         (775,463     (939,055     (213,716

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     3,287,540         3,665,529         3,816,196         (877,297     (610,585     (771,512

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

               

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

     8,065,963         6,381,215         12,015,660         (91,086     (502,682     626,341   

RiverSource Real Estate

     1,498,361         1,227,857         1,667,040         (83,163     (18,514     138,649   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

               

Columbia Floating Rate

     2,466,113         2,210,544         3,509,190         226,409        (61,933     293,676   

Columbia Income Opportunities

     4,451,807         1,913,521         1,767,885         313,169        291,601        196,944   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     2,886,405         3,322,371         2,554,103         (354,181     (115,062     (238,396

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     21,017,705         9,909,438         17,556,244         (4,112,307     268,796        726,080   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     2,186,361         844,435         792,200         (272,368     (68,816     (78,320

Columbia Money Market

     8,951,478         12,658,313         15,026,220         (13,410,378     (1,868,463     1,290,897   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     851,036         853,191         365,578         162,170        143,015        125,645   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     375,114         363,926         286,759         55,844        47,195        33,868   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

               

Columbia Diversified Bond

     19,593,287         15,648,683         14,772,880         (1,381,496     (2,314,025     (461,298

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     1,360,384         1,230,393         1,246,083         44,953        196,213        506,328   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     645,263         663,711         715,946         31,789        73,054        44,499   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     224,128         220,172         242,807         (994     9,792        75,790   

 

110


Table of Contents

 

     Management Fees     Nonadvisory expenses  
     2009     2008     2007     2009     2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

            

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   $ 17,053,076      $ 44,177,652      $ 42,530,087      $ 1,037,819      $ 1,905,627      $ 1,561,033   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     2,033,555        905,956        114,048 (d)      214,462        195,661        54,709 (d) 

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     661,677        6,618 (e)      N/A        168,055        2,877 (e)      N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     9,896,881        18,813,340        15,908,732        776,726        992,201        826,273   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     6,604,411        10,108,947        11,025,000        585,299        1,047,907        921,198   

RiverSource Balanced

     2,483,462        3,977,541        6,315,077        346,693        437,940        368,447   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     1,081,850        904,660        168,875 (d)      246,334        294,099        76,656 (d) 

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

     164,150        173,288        174,700        32,933        53,665        32,890   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

     192,624        196,281        214,476        60,833        90,615        72,092   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

     324,501        351,237        375,995        68,180        99,131        88,809   

Seligman New York Municipal

     352,211        332,574        342,695        75,556        88,770        71,419   

Seligman National Municipal

     1,147,080        304,747        327,359        62,006        106,685        95,664   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     121,554        207,083        184,907        (54,705     (4,193     7,243   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     136,473        210,264        157,846        (68,782     (13,470     (551

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     35,438        32,294        6,852        (18,456     (5,254     (15,347

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     19,710        22,283        4,354        (12,505     (3,570     (4,094

Seligman TargETFund Core

     272,984        457,038        382,979        (119,771     (10,950     17,561   

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

            

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

     4,698,565        4,188,137        887,341        205,127        313,877        103,119   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

     78,072 (f)      N/A        N/A        21,500 (f)      N/A        N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     1,320,292        1,182,004        706,943        82,201        172,124        120,044   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     3,791,476        7,352,591        7,106,815        524,327        1,138,897        1,190,259   

Columbia European Equity

     600,499        980,629        952,484        (31,736     223,792        199,237   

Columbia Frontier

     321,582        579,499        766,116        (20,898     200,110        250,909   

Columbia Global Bond

     3,551,274        5,074,934        3,438,893        (33,836     165,694        (17,529

Columbia Global Equity

     2,918,784        5,825,153        6,075,014        350,276        554,139        577,463   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     64,424        16,485 (g)      N/A        4,234        1,122 (g)      N/A   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

     5,749,639        13,239,202        20,067,871        511,602        1,054,830        1,286,758   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

     2,551,543        3,571,473        3,876,481        386,252        680,094        707,762   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     2,174,525        5,209,129        2,161,563        252,387        512,793        358,005   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     3,240,723        5,965,413        6,048,963        (660,493     334,550        672,542   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     496,177        1,057,146        1,270,558        (45,193     63,912        208,621   

 

111


Table of Contents

 

     Management Fees      Nonadvisory expenses  
     2009      2008     2007      2009     2008     2007  

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   $ 177,834       $ 15,723 (g)      N/A       $ 25,200      $ 2,989 (g)      N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     3,074,518         4,661,800      $ 4,923,040         283,182        486,074      $ 545,663   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

              

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     2,699,258         2,764,541        3,157,092         48,345        506,736        (8,650

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     4,488,355         4,726,590        6,373,531         281,069        437,496        241,412   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     339,947         291,762        321,011         8,313        2,588        (4,565

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     10,226,940         11,447,732        13,006,578         (1,338,742     2,984,232        (847,490

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

              

Columbia Government Money Market

     518,174         893,335        776,197         (1,105,030     6,551        300,969   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     1,486,938         1,732,331        2,163,189         292,721        282,371        293,338   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     1,687,329         2,048,229        3,132,296         (186,016     295,691        337,798   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     25,152,110         28,854,808        34,908,273         1,991,333        2,540,656        2,783,442   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     114,310         243,213        297,971         (8,058     221,303        (104,511

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     208,539         460,038        827,966         (107,139     177,277        (30,072

Seligman Capital

     1,731,065         2,912,130        3,982,898         370,916        386,885        427,027   

Seligman Growth

     4,254,428         2,534,267        3,101,571         85,442        387,623        404,127   

 

(a) The fund changed its fiscal year end effective Jan. 31, 2008 from May 31 to Jan. 31. For 2008, the information shown is for the period from June 1, 2007 through Jan. 31, 2008. For years prior to 2008, the fiscal period ended on May 31.
(b) For the period from Oct. 18, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2008.
(c) For the fiscal period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(d) For the period from May 17, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2007.
(e) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(f) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when the Fund became available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(g) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2008.

Manager of Managers Exemption

The funds have received an order from the SEC that permits Columbia Management, subject to the approval of the Board, to appoint a subadviser or change the terms of a subadvisory agreement for a fund without first obtaining shareholder approval. The order permits the fund to add or change unaffiliated subadvisers or the fees paid to subadvisers from time to time without the expense and delays associated with obtaining shareholder approval of the change.

For all Seligman funds and for Columbia Frontier, Columbia Seligman Global Technology, Columbia Seligman Communications and Information, Columbia Select Large-Cap Value, Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value, RiverSource California Tax-Exempt, RiverSource Cash Management, Columbia Diversified Bond, Columbia Global Bond, Columbia High Yield Bond, RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt, Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt, RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt, RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government, Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond, RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income and Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage funds: if the fund was to seek to rely on the order, holders of a majority of the fund’s outstanding voting securities would need to approve operating the fund in this manner. There is no assurance shareholder approval, if sought, will be received, and no changes will be made without shareholder approval until that time.

Subadvisory Agreements

The assets of certain funds are managed by subadvisers that have been selected by the investment manager, subject to the review and approval of the Board. The investment manager has recommended the subadvisers to the Board based upon its assessment of the skills of the subadvisers in managing other assets with objectives and investment strategies substantially similar to those of the applicable fund. Short-term investment performance is not the only factor in selecting or terminating a

 

112


Table of Contents

subadviser, and the investment manager does not expect to make frequent changes of subadvisers. Certain subadvisers, affiliated with the investment manager, have been directly approved by shareholders. These subadvisers are noted in Table 17.

The investment manager allocates the assets of a fund with multiple subadvisers among the subadvisers. Each subadviser has discretion, subject to oversight by the Board and the investment manager, to purchase and sell portfolio assets, consistent with the fund’s investment objectives, policies, and restrictions. Generally, the services that a subadviser provides to the fund are limited to asset management and related recordkeeping services.

The investment manager has entered into an advisory agreement with each subadviser under which the subadviser provides investment advisory assistance and day-to-day management of some or all of the fund’s portfolio, as well as investment research and statistical information. A subadviser may also serve as a discretionary or non-discretionary investment adviser to management or advisory accounts that are unrelated in any manner to the investment manager or its affiliates.

The following table shows the advisory fee schedules for fees paid by the investment manager to subadvisers for funds that have subadvisers. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 17. Subadvisers and Subadvisory Agreement Fee Schedules

 

Fund

  

Subadviser

   Parent
Company
    

Fee Schedule

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

     

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

  

Barrow, Hanley, Mewhinney & Strauss (BHMS)(a)

(effective March 12, 2004)

     A       1.00% on the first $10 million, reducing to 0.30% as assets increase
  

Donald Smith & Co., Inc.

(Donald Smith)(a)

(effective March 12, 2004)

     N/A       0.60% on the first $175 million, reducing to 0.55% as assets increase
  

Metropolitan West Capital Management, LLC (MetWest Capital)

(effective April 24, 2006)

     B       0.50% on all assets
  

Turner Investment Partners, Inc. (Turner)

(effective Feb. 19, 2010)

     N/A       0.50% on the first $50 million, reducing to 0.35% as assets increase.(a)

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

  

Davis Selected Advisers, LP (Davis)(a), (b)

(effective June 18, 2001)

     N/A       0.45% on the first $100 million, reducing to 0.25% as assets increase

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

     

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

  

Threadneedle International Limited(b)
(Threadneedle)

(effective July 15, 2009)

     D       0.50% on the first $250 million, reducing to 0.40% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(c)

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

  

Threadneedle(b)

(effective July 9, 2004)

     D       0.45% of the first $150 million, reducing to 0.30% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(c)

Columbia European Equity

  

Threadneedle(b)

(effective July 9, 2004)

     D       0.35% of the first $150 million, reducing to 0.20% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(c)

Columbia Global Equity

  

Threadneedle(b)

(effective July 9, 2004)

     D       0.35% of the first $150 million, reducing to 0.20% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(b)

 

113


Table of Contents

 

Fund

  

Subadviser

   Parent
Company
  

Fee Schedule

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

  

Threadneedle(b)

(effective Aug. 1, 2008)

   D    0.70% of the first $250 million, reducing to 0.60% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(c)

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

  

AllianceBernstein L.P. (AllianceBernstein)

(effective Sept. 17, 2001)

   N/A    0.65% on the first $75 million, reducing to 0.30% as assets increase
  

Mondrian Investment Partners Limited (Mondrian)

(effective August 18, 2008)

   N/A    0.70% on all assets
  

Tradewinds Global Investors, LLC (Tradewinds)

(effective August 18, 2008)

   N/A    0.50% on the first $250 million, reducing to 0.40 as assets increase

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

  

Columbia Wanger Asset Management L.P. (Columbia WAM)(a),(d)

(effective Sept. 5, 2001)

   C    0.70% on the first $150 million, reducing to 0.50% as assets increase

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

  

Columbia WAM(a),(d)

(effective Aug. 10, 2009)

   C    0.70% on the first $150 million, reducing to 0.50% as assets increase

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

  

Threadneedle(b)

(effective Aug. 1, 2008)

   D    0.45% of the first $250 million, reducing to 0.35% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(c)

Threadneedle International Opportunity

  

Threadneedle(b)

(effective July 9, 2004)

   D    0.35% of the first $150 million, reducing to 0.20% as assets increase, and subject to a performance incentive adjustment(c)

For funds with fiscal period ended December 31

     

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

  

LaSalle Investment Management (Securities), L.P. (LaSalle Securities U.S.)

(since inception)

   E    0.30% on the first $37 million, 0.65% on the next $43 million, and 0.49% thereafter.

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

  

LaSalle Securities U.S.

(since inception)

   E    0.30% on the first $58 million, 0.65% on the next $42 million, and 0.45% thereafter.

 

(a) The fee is calculated based on the combined net assets subject to the subadviser’s investment management.
(b) Davis is a 1940 Act affiliate of the investment manager because it owns or has owned more than 5% of the publicly issued securities of the investment manager’s parent company, Ameriprise Financial. Threadneedle is an affiliate of the investment manager as an indirect, wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial.
(c) The adjustment for Threadneedle is based on the performance of one Class A share of the fund and the change in the PIA Index described in Table 14. The performance of the fund and the Index will be calculated using the method described above for the performance incentive adjustment paid to the investment manager under the terms of the Investment Management Services Agreement. The amount of the adjustment to Threadneedle’s fee, whether positive or negative, shall be equal to the following amount of the performance incentive adjustment made to the investment management fee payable to the investment manager under the terms of the Investment Management Services Agreement: 50% for Threadneedle Emerging Markets, Threadneedle European Equity, Threadneedle Global Equity and Threadneedle International Opportunity; 100% for Threadneedle Global Equity Income and Threadneedle Global Extended Alpha. The performance incentive adjustment was effective Dec. 1, 2004.
(d) On May 1, 2010, Ameriprise Financial announced the closing of its acquisition of the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC, including Columbia WAM, from Bank of America (the “Columbia Transaction”). As a result of the Columbia Transaction, Columbia WAM is an indirect, wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial.
A – BHMS is an independent-operating subsidiary of Old Mutual Asset Management.
B – Metropolitan West Capital Management, LLC (MetWest Capital) is a subsidiary of Wells Fargo & Company and operates within the Evergreen Investments unit of its asset management division.
C – Columbia WAM is an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of Columbia Management Group, Inc., which in turn is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Bank of America Corporation.
D – Threadneedle is an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of Ameriprise Financial.
E – LaSalle Investment Management (Securities), L.P. is an affiliate of Jones Lang LaSalle Incorporated.

 

114


Table of Contents

 

The following table shows the subadvisory fees paid by the investment manager to subadvisers in the last three fiscal periods. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 18. Subadvisory Fees

 

          Subadvisory Fees Paid  

Fund

  

Subadviser

   2010     2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

      

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   BHMS    $ 491,375      $ 437,027      $ 865,372   
   Donald Smith      587,548        497,789        984,692   
   MetWest Capital      491,635        466,432        955,503   
   Turner      89,142 (a)      N/A        N/A   
   Former subadviser: Franklin Portfolio Associates (from March 2004 to June 6, 2008)      N/A        22,583        964,510   
   Former subadviser: Federated MDTA, LLC (from June 6, 2008 to Feb. 19, 2010)      325,109        443,715        N/A (a) 

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   Davis      1,688,264        2,020,698        3,220,929   
          2009     2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

      

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

   Threadneedle      42,462 (e)      N/A        N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   Threadneedle      1,469,749        2,801,637        2,728,720   

Columbia European Equity

   Threadneedle      260,772        443,279        406,594   

Columbia Global Equity

   Threadneedle      1,168,151        2,269,177        2,408,387   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

   Threadneedle      43,117        11,750 (f)      N/A   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   AllianceBernstein      2,170,338        6,268,208        7,962,307   
   Mondrian      714,196        77,048 (b)      N/A   
   Tradewinds      1,116,798        129,124 (b)      N/A   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   Columbia WAM      956,567        1,557,963        1,568,158   
   Former subadviser: Principal Global Investors, LLC (from April 24, 2006 to May 6, 2010)      866,239        1,849,485        1,760,150   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   Columbia WAM      41,203 (c)      N/A        N/A   
   Former subadviser: Batterymarch Financial Management, Inc. (from April 24, 2006 to April 30, 2010)      188,913        386,194        439,593   
   Former subadviser: AIG Global Investment Corp. (from April 24, 2006 to Aug. 7, 2009)      127,498 (d)      355,245        425,696   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   Threadneedle      104,654        9,057 (f)      N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   Threadneedle      1,254,178        1,907,215        1,895,712   

For funds with fiscal period ended December 31

      

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

   LaSalle Securities U.S.    $ 36,482        121,606        148,985   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

   LaSalle Securities U.S.      71,093        230,019        413,983   

 

(a) The subadviser did not begin managing the fund until after the fund’s fiscal year end.
(b) For the fiscal period from Aug. 18, 2008 to Oct. 31, 2008.
(c) For the fiscal period from Aug. 10, 2009 to Oct. 31, 2009.

 

115


Table of Contents

 

(d) For the fiscal period from Nov. 1, 2008 to Aug. 7, 2009.
(e) For the fiscal period from July 15, 2009 to Oct. 31, 2009.
(f) For the fiscal period from Aug. 1, 2008 to Oct. 31, 2008.

Portfolio Managers. For funds other than money market funds, the following table provides information about the fund’s portfolio managers as of the end of the most recent fiscal period, unless otherwise noted. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table  1.

Table 19. Portfolio Managers

 

        

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

     Ownership
of Fund
Shares
     Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
    Structure of
Compensation
 

Fund

   Portfolio Manager  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net Assets

   Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
         

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

          

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   Colin Lundgren  

16 RICs

16 other accounts

   $1.34 billion $271.73 million      None         None         (6     (18
   Gene R. Tannuzzo(j)  

1 RIC

2 other accounts

  

$341.48 million

$0.08 million

     None         None        

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

   Colin Lundgren  

16 RICs

16 other accounts

   $1.18 billion $271.73 million      None        
 
$100,001 –
$500,000
  
  
     (6     (18
   Gene R. Tannuzzo(j)  

1 RIC

2 other accounts

  

$341.48 million

$0.08 million

     None         None        

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

   Colin Lundgren  

16 RICs

16 other accounts

   $1.38 billion $271.73 million      None         None         (6     (18
   Gene R. Tannuzzo(j)  

1 RIC

2 other accounts

  

$341.48 million

$0.08 million

     None         None        

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

   Kent M. Bergene(b)  

5 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.36 million

     None        

 

$  50,001 –

$100,000

  

  

     (1     (19
   David M. Joy  

5 RICs

6 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.01 million

     None         None        
   Anwiti Bahuguna(k)   17 RICs    $2.1 billion      None         None         (3     (32
    

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

          
   Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

     None         None        
   Kent Peterson(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

     None         None        
   Marie M. Schofield(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

     None         None        

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

   Kent M. Bergene(b)  

5 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.36 million

     None        

 

$  50,001 –

$100,000

  

  

     (1     (19
   David M. Joy  

5 RICs

6 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.01 million

     None         None        
   Anwiti Bahuguna(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

     None         None      

 

(3

 

 

(32

   Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

     None         None        
   Kent Peterson(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

     None         None        
   Marie M. Schofield(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

     None         None        

 

116


Table of Contents
        

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

   Ownership
of Fund
Shares
   Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
    Structure of
Compensation
 

Fund

   Portfolio Manager  

Number and Type
of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net Assets

   Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
       

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

   Kent M.
Bergene(b)
 

5 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.36 million

   None    $  50,001 –

$100,000

     (1     (19
   David M. Joy  

5 RICs

6 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.01 million

   None    None     
   Anwiti
Bahuguna(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None      (3     (32
   Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

   None    None     
   Kent Peterson(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None     
   Marie M.
Schofield(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

   None    None     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

   Kent M.
Bergene(b)
 

5 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.36 million

   None    $  50,001 –

$100,000

     (1     (19
   David M. Joy  

5 RICs

6 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.01 million

   None    None     
   Anwiti
Bahuguna(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None      (3     (32
   Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

   None    None     
   Kent Peterson(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None     
   Marie M.
Schofield(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

   None    None     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

   Kent M.
Bergene(b)
 

5 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$3.56 billion

$1.36 million

   None    $10,001 –

$50,000

     (1     (19
   David M. Joy  

5 RICs

6 other accounts

  

$3.56 billion

$1.01 million

   None    None     
   Anwiti
Bahuguna(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None      (3     (32
   Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

   None    None     
   Kent Peterson(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None     
   Marie M.
Schofield(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

   None    None     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

   Kent M.
Bergene(b)
 

5 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.36 million

   None    $  50,001 –

$100,000

     (1     (19
   David M. Joy  

5 RICs

6 other accounts

  

$3.30 billion

$1.01 million

   None    None     
   Anwiti
Bahuguna(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None      (3     (32
   Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

   None    None     
   Kent Peterson(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

  

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

   None    None     
   Marie M.
Schofield(k)
 

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

  

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

   None    None     

 

117


Table of Contents
         

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

   Ownership
of Fund
Shares
   Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
    Structure of
Compensation
 

Fund

  

Portfolio Manager

  

Number and Type

of Account*

  

Approximate
Total Net Assets

  

Performance Based

Accounts(a)

       
RiverSource S&P 500 Index    Alfred F. Alley III(k)    4 RICs    $6.5 billion    None    None      (3     (32
     

3 PIVs

19 other accounts

  

$175.0 million

$4.0 billion

          
RiverSource Small Company Index    Alfred F. Alley III(k)    4 RICs    $6.5 billion    None    None      (3     (32
     

3 PIVs

19 other accounts

  

$175.0 million

$4.0 billion

          
For funds with fiscal period ending March 31              
Columbia Equity Value    Steve Schroll    12 RICs    $14.61 billion    8 RICs ($14.05 B)    $50,001 –      (2     (20
      2 PIVs    $69.61 million       $100,000     
      18 other accounts(d)    $538.36 million           
   Laton Spahr   

12 RICs

2 PIVs

  

$14.61 billion

$69.61 million

   8 RICs ($14.05 B)    $100,001 –

$500,000

    
      17 other accounts(d)    $538.66 million           
   Paul Stocking   

12 RICs

2 PIVs

  

$14.61 billion

$69.61 million

   8 RICs ($14.05 B)    $50,001 –

$100,000

    
      21 other accounts(d)    $543.80 million           
RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining    Michael E. Hoover(k)    1 RIC    $689.7 million    None    None      (3     (32
     

3 PIVs

3 other accounts

  

$689.7 million

$0.74 million

          
For funds with fiscal period ending April 30              
Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity    Steve Schroll    12 RICs    $14.76 billion    8 RICs ($14.2 B)    $10,001 –      (2     (20
      2 PIVs    $70.44 million       $50,000     
      18 other accounts(d)    $539.06 million           
   Laton Spahr   

12 RICs

2 PIVs

17 other accounts(d)

  

$14.76 billion

$70.44 million

$539.57 million

   8 RICs ($14.2 B)    $500,001 –

$1,000,000

    
   Paul Stocking    12 RICs    $14.76 billion    8 RICs ($14.2 B)    $100,001 –     
      2 PIVs    $70.44 million       $500,000     
      21 other accounts(d)    $544.59 million           
Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure    Warren Spitz    None    None    None    Over
$1,000,000
     (2     (20
Columbia Retirement Plus 2010    Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)    6 RICs    $4.13 billion    None    None      (1     (19
      8 other accounts    $1.50 million           
   David M. Joy(l)   

6 RICs

7 other accounts

  

$4.13 billion

$1.13 million

   None    None     
   Anwiti Bahuguna(l)    17 RICs    $2.1 billion    None    None   

 

(3

 

 

(32

      26 PIVs    $2.5 billion           
      21 other accounts    $243 million           
   Colin Moore(l)    19 RICs    $3.56 billion    None    None     
      26 PIVs    $2.5 billion           
      20 other accounts    $246 million           
   Kent Peterson(l)    17 RICs    $2.1 billion    None    None     
      26 PIVs    $2.5 billion           
      20 other accounts    $243 million           
   Marie M. Schofield(l)    17 RICs    $2.1 billion    None    None     
      26 PIVs    $2.5 billion           
      17 other accounts    $243 million           

 

118


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate
Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation
 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None     (1     (19
    8 other accounts   $1.50 million        
  David M. Joy(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   $1-$10,000    
    7 other accounts   $1.13 million        
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   8 other accounts   $1.50 million   None   None     (1     (19
  David M. Joy(l)  

6 RICs

7 other accounts

 

$4.13 billion

$1.13 million

  None   None    
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None     (1     (19
    8 other accounts   $1.50 million        
  David M. Joy(l)  

6 RICs

7 other accounts

 

$4.13 billion

$1.13 million

  None   None    
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None     (1     (19
    8 other accounts   $1.50 million        
  David M. Joy(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None    
    7 other accounts   $1.13 million        
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

 

119


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation
 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None     (1     (19
    8 other accounts   $1.50 million        
  David M. Joy(l)  

6 RICs

7 other accounts

 

$4.13 billion

$1.13 million

  None   None    
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None     (1     (19
    8 other accounts   $1.50 million        
  David M. Joy(l)  

6 RICs

7 other accounts

 

$4.13 billion

$1.13 million

  None   None    
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

  Kent M. Bergene(b),(l)   6 RICs   $4.13 billion   None   None     (1     (19
    8 other accounts   $1.50 million        
  David M. Joy(l)  

6 RICs

7 other accounts

 

$4.13 billion

$1.13 million

  None   None    
  Anwiti Bahuguna(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    21 other accounts   $243 million        
  Colin Moore(l)   19 RICs   $3.56 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $246 million        
  Kent Peterson(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    20 other accounts   $243 million        
  Marie M. Schofield(l)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None    
    26 PIVs   $2.5 billion        
    17 other accounts   $243 million        

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

           

Columbia High Yield Bond

  Jennifer Ponce de Leon   6 RICs   $4.04 billion   2 RICs ($527.4 M)   None     (2     (23
   

1 PIV

27 other accounts

 

$9.33 million

$4.58 billion

       
  Brian Lavin  

12 RICs

1 PIV

4 other account

 

$8.92 billion

$9.33 million

$683.4 million

  None   None    

 

120


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of  Interest
   

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

 

Donald Smith:

Donald G. Smith

  2 RICs   $832.0 million   1 RIC ($790 M);      
  Richard L. Greenberg   1 PIV   $67.0 million   1 other account ($68 M)   None   (10)   (26)
    33 other accounts   $2.0 billion        
  BHMS:            
  James S. McClure   4 RICs   $824.6 million        
  John P. Harloe   1 PIV   $5.4 million   None   None   (12)   (27)
    15 other accounts   $572.3 million        
  MetWest:            
  Samir Sikka   5 RICs   $472.7 million   1 other account   None   (13)   (28)
   

3 PIVs

12 other accounts

 

$84.3 million

$193.8 million

  ($53.9 M)      
  Turner:            
  David Kovacs   4 RICs   $315.0 million   1 PIV ($2 M)   None   (5)   (21)
   

7 PIVs

6 other accounts

 

$46.0 million

$23930 million

       

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

  Jason J. Callan   4 RICs   $1.84 billion   None   None   (2)   (23)
    3 other accounts   $0.34 million        
  Tom Heuer  

4 RICs

2 other accounts

 

$1.84 billion

$0.40 million

  None   None    

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

  Davis:            
  Christopher C. Davis  

26 RICs

12 PIVs

117 other accounts(e)

 

$54.0 billion

$1.0 billion

$8.0 billion

  None   None(f)   (9)   (25)
  Kenneth C. Feinberg  

24 RICs

11 PIVs

107 other accounts(e)

 

$54.0 billion

$1.0 billion

$7.0 billion

       

RiverSource Short

Duration U.S. Government

  Leonard A. Aplet(m)   11 RICs   $2.90 billion   None   None   (3)   (32)
   

8 PIVs

85 other accounts

 

$3.56 billion

$10.93 billion

       
  Gregory S. Liechty(m)  

1 RICs

13 other accounts

 

$2.48 billion

$71.3 million

  None   None    
  Ronald B. Stahl(m)  

11 RICs

6 PIVs

53 other accounts

 

$2.90 billion

$785.66 million

$3.88 billion

  None   None    

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

           

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

  Steve Schroll   12 RICs   $12.06 billion   8 RICs ($11.57 M)   $100,001- $500,000    
   

2 PIVs

21 other accounts(d)

 

$58.92 million

$467.85 million

       
  Laton Spahr   12 RICs   $12.06 billion   8 RICs ($11.57 M)   $100,001- $500,000    
   

2 PIVs

17 other accounts(d)

 

$58.92 million

$468.59 million

       
  Paul Stocking   12 RICs   $12.06 billion   8 RICs ($11.57 M)   $10,001- $50,000   (2)   (20)
    2 PIVs   $58.92 million        
    18 other accounts(d)   $473.07 million        

RiverSource Real Estate

  Arthur J. Hurley   1 RIC   $332.0 million   None   None   (3)   (32)
    7 other accounts   $0.40 million        

 

121


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

    Ownership
of Fund
Shares
    Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
        Structure of
Compensation
 

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

           

Columbia Floating Rate

  Lynn Hopton   11 PIVs   $4.85 billion     None        None        (2     (29
    11 other accounts   $440.11 million        
  Yvonne Stevens  

11 PIVs

11 other accounts

 

$4.85 billion

$436.48 million

    None        None       
  Steve Staver   5 other accounts   $0.81 million     None        None       

Columbia Income Opportunities

  Brian Lavin   12 RICs   $8.19 billion     None        None        (2     (23
   

1 PIV

3 other account

 

$10.40 million

$684.85 million

       

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

  Nicholas Pifer(m)   6 RICs   $4.67 billion     None        None        (2     (23
   

3 PIVs

19 other accounts

 

$21.58 million

$4.99 billion

       
  VishaI Khanduja  

1 RIC

3 other accounts

 

$2.24 billion

$0.09 million

    None        None       

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

  Brian M. Condon   12 RICs   $4.92 billion     1 PIV ($23 M)        None        (3     (32
   

8 PIVs

43 other accounts

 

$707 million

$2.63 billion

       

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

  Tom Murphy   6 RICs   $12.38 billion     2 RICs ($1.53 B);        Over        (2     (23
    2 PIVs   $715.72 million     1 other account        1,000,000       
    17 other accounts   $12.88 billion     ($30.68 M)         
  Timothy J. Doubek  

1 RIC

5 other account

 

$2.05 billion

$31.88 million

   

 

1 other account

($30.68 M)

  

  

   

 

$10,001 –

$50,000

  

  

   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

  Brian M. Condon   12 RICs   $8.52 billion     1 PIV ($23 M)        None        (3     (32
   

8 PIVs

43 other accounts

 

$707 million

$2.63 billion

       
  Alfred F. Alley III  

6 RICs

6 PIVs

17 other accounts

 

$6.81 billion

$846.76 million

$1.28 billion

    None        None       

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Value

  Brian M. Condon   12 RICs   $8.61 billion     1 PIV ($23 M)        None        (3     (32
   

8 PIVs

43 other accounts

 

$707 million

$2.63 billion

       
  Alfred F. Alley III  

6 RICs

6 PIVs

17 other accounts

 

$6.90 billion

$846.76 million

$1.28 billion

    None        None       

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

           

Columbia Diversified Bond

  Tom Murphy   5 RICs   $7.96 billion     2 RICs ($1.46 B);        $10,001 –        (2     (23
    2 PIVs   $709.69 million     1 other account        $50,000       
    18 other accounts   $13.30 billion     ($29.94 M)         
  Jennifer Ponce de Leon  

6 RICs

27 other accounts

 

$5.60 billion

$4.68 billion

   

 

 

2 RICs ($1.46 B);

1 other account

($29.94 M)

  

  

  

    None       
  Colin Lundgren  

22 RICs

9 other accounts

 

$38.96 billion

$272.65 million

    2 RICs ($1.46 B)       

 

$100,001 –

$500,000

  

  

   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $4.15 billion     None        None        (2     (23
    12 other accounts   $6.80 billion        
  Mary Grindland(n)  

1 RIC

6 other accounts

 

$67.34 billion

$0.42 million

    None       

 

$10,001 –

$50,000

  

  

   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $4.35 billion     None        None        (2     (23
    12 other accounts   $6.80 billion        

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $4.45 billion     None        None        (2     (23
    12 other accounts   $6.80 billion        

For fund with fiscal period ending September 30

         

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

  Laton Spahr  

12 RICs

2 PIVs

 

$9.59 billion

$48.35 million

    8 RICs ($9.09 B)       
 
$100,001 –
$500,000
  
  
   
    16 other accounts(d)   $2.96 billion        
  Steve Schroll   12 RICs   $9.59 billion       $50,001 –        (2     (20
    2 PIVs   $48.35 million       $100,000       
    18 other accounts(d)   $2.42 billion        
  Paul Stocking  

12 RICs

2 PIVs

 

$9.59 billion

$48.35 million

     

 

$100,001 –

$500,000

  

  

   
    21 other accounts(d)   $6.91 billion        

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

  Brian M. Condon(k)   3 RICs   $594.0 million     1 PIV ($22 M)        None        (3     (32
   

8 PIVs

40 other accounts

 

$864.0 million

$2.72 billion

       

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

  Brian M. Condon(k)   3 RICs   $594.0 million     1 PIV ($22 M)        None        (3     (32
   

8 PIVs

40 other accounts

 

$864.0 million

$2.72 billion

       

 

122


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation
 

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

  Laton Spahr  

12 RICs

2 PIVs

 

$12.07 billion

$48.35 million

    $100,001 –
$500,000
   
    16 other accounts(d)   $2.96 billion        
  Steve Schroll   12 RICs   $12.07 billion   8 RICs ($11.58 B)   $50,001 –     (2     (20
    2 PIVs   $48.35 million     $100,000    
    18 other accounts(d)   $2.42 billion        
  Paul Stocking  

12 RICs

2 PIVs

 

$12.07 billion

$48.35 million

    $100,001 –

$500,000

   
    21 other accounts(d)   $6.91 billion        

Columbia Strategic Allocation

  Anwiti Bahuguna(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

22 other accounts

 

$2.1 billion

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

  None   None    
  Colin Moore(k)  

19 RICs

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

 

$3.62 billion

$2.4 billion

$299.0 million

  None   None    
  Kent Peterson(k)   17 RICs   $2.1 billion   None   None     (3     (32
   

26 PIVs

21 other accounts

 

$2.4 billion

$296.0 million

       
  Marie M. Schofield(k)  

17 RICs

26 PIVs

16 other accounts

 

$2.1 million

$2.4 million

$296.0 million

  None   None    
  David M. Joy(j)   6 RICs   $4.07 billion   None   None     (2     (19
    6 other accounts   $1.12 million        

RiverSource Balanced

  Steve Schroll   12 RICs   $13.73 billion   8 RICs ($13.23 B)   None     (2     (20
   

2 PIVs

18 other accounts(d)

 

$48.35 million

$2.42 billion

       
  Laton Spahr  

12 RICs

2 PIVs

16 other accounts(d)

 

$13.73 billion

$48.35 million

$2.42 billion

  8 RICs ($13.23 B)   $1– $10,000    
  Paul Stocking  

12 RICs

2 PIVs

21 other accounts(d)

 

$13.73 billion

$48.35 million

$2.42 billion

  8 RICs ($13.23 B)   None    
  Tom Murphy   6 RICs   $10.40 billion   2 RICs ($729.4 M)   None     (2     (23
   

2 PIVs

18 other accounts

 

$835.61 million

$15.33 billion

       
  Jennifer Ponce de Leon(l)  

4 RICs

1 PIV

28 other accounts

 

$5.49 billion

$9.56 million

$4.89 billion

  None   None    
  Colin Lundgren(j)   17 RICs   $1.59 billion   None   None    
    15 other accounts   $203.49 million        

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

  Colin Lundgren  

16 RICs

14 other accounts

 

$1.24 billion

$1.22 billion

  None   None    
  Gene R. Tannuzzo   2 other accounts   $0.04 million   None   $1- $10,000     (2     (23
  Brian Lavin(l)   2 RICs   $2.92 billion   None   None    
    1 PIV   $9.56 million        
    4 other account   $766.77 million        

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

  Catherine Stienstra  

10 RICs

11 other accounts

 

$4.64 billion

$6.76 billion

  None   None     (2     (23

Seligman California Municipal Quality

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $4.64 billion   None   None     (2     (23
    11 other accounts   $6.76 billion        

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $4.61 billion   None   None     (2     (23
    11 other accounts   $6.76 billion        

Seligman National Municipal

  Kimberly Campbell(m)   7 RICs   $3.40 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    18 other accounts   $0.93 billion        

Seligman New York Municipal

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $4.59 billion   None   None     (2     (23
    11 other accounts   $6.76 billion        

Seligman TargETFund 2015

  John Schonberg   6 RICs   $1.23 billion   2 RICs ($1.12 B)   None     (2     (37
   

2 PIVs

5 other accounts

 

$20.41 million

$1.13 million

       
  Gary Terpening   4 RICs   $107.69 million   None   None     (2     (26
    3 other accounts   $0.40 million        

Seligman TargETFund 2025

  John Schonberg   6 RICs   $1.23 billion   2 RICs ($1.12 B)   None     (2     (37
   

2 PIVs

5 other accounts

 

$20.41 million

$1.13 million

       
  Gary Terpening   4 RICs   $99.96 million   None   $100,001 –     (2     (26
    3 other accounts   $0.40 million     $500,000    

 

123


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of  Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation
 

Seligman TargETFund 2035

  John Schonberg   6 RICs   $1.23 billion   2 RICs ($1.12 B)   None     (2     (37
   

2 PIVs

5 other accounts

 

$20.41 million

$1.13 million

       
  Gary Terpening   4 RICs   $124.47 million   None   None     (2     (26
    3 other accounts   $0.40 million        

Seligman TargETFund 2045

  John Schonberg   6 RICs   $1.23 billion   2 RICs ($1.12 B)   None     (2     (37
   

2 PIVs

5 other accounts

 

$20.41 million

$1.13 million

       
  Gary Terpening   4 RICs   $129.70 million   None   None     (2     (26
    3 other accounts   $0.40 million        

Seligman TargETFund Core

  John Schonberg   6 RICs   $1.23 billion   2 RICs ($1.12 B)   None     (2     (37
   

2 PIVs

5 other accounts

 

$20.41 million

$1.13 million

       
  Gary Terpening   4 RICs   $75.53 million   None   None     (2     (26
    3 other accounts   $0.40 million        

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

         

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

  Nicholas Pifer   5 RICs   $4.79 billion   None   $50,001 –     (2     (23
    3 PIVs   $33.59 million     $100,000    
    17 other accounts(d)   $6.27 billion        

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

  Threadneedle:            
  Vanessa Donegan   2 PIVs   $2.17 billion   1 other ($156.61 M)   None(g)     (14     (36
    7 other accounts   $4.16 billion        
  Rafael Polatinsky  

1 PIV

4 other accounts

 

$201.29 million

$20.0 billion

  None      

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

  Nicholas Pifer   5 RICs   $4.77 billion   None   $10,001 –     (2     (23
    3 PIVs   $33.59 million     $50,000    
    17 other accounts(d)   $6.27 billion        
  Jim Carlene  

4 PIVs

7 other accounts

 

$174.53 million

$966.74 million

    $10,001 –

$50,000

   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

  Threadneedle:            
  Vanessa Donegan(m)   2 PIVs   $1.96 billion   1 other ($156.61 M)   None(g)     (14     (36
    6 other accounts   $2.76 billion        
  Rafael Polatinsky(m)  

1 PIV

3 other accounts

 

$224.26 million

$554.09 million

  None      

Columbia European Equity

  Threadneedle:            
  Dan Ison   4 PIVs   $211.49 million   1 PIV ($86.38 M)   None(g)     (14     (36

Columbia Frontier

  John K. Schonberg(j)   8 RICs   $1.98 billion   2 RICs ($1.55 B)   None     (2     (37
   

2 PIVs

6 other accounts

 

$27.61 million

$1.26 million

       
  Sam Murphy(j)  

2 RICs

3 other accounts

 

$1.55 billion

$0.15 million

  2 RICs ($1.55 B)   None    
  Mike Marzolf(j)  

2 RICs

3 other accounts

 

$1.55 billion

$0.081 million

  2 RICs ($1.55 B)   None    

Columbia Global Bond

  Nicholas Pifer   5 RICs   $4.51 billion   None   $50,001 –     (2     (23
    3 PIVs   $33.59 million     $100,000    
    17 other accounts(d)   $6.27 billion        

Columbia Global Equity

  Threadneedle:            
  Stephen Thornber   2 RICs   $28.09 million   None   None(g)     (14     (36
   

3 PIVs

3 other accounts

 

$779.53 million

$411.64 million

       
  Andrew Holliman  

2 RICs

6 PIVs

 

$7.50 million

$1.63 billion

  1 RIC, 1 PIV

($16.2 M)

     

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

  Threadneedle:            
  Andrew Holliman  

1 RICs

6 PIVs

 

$481.64 million

$1.63 billion

  1 RIC, 1 PIV

($16.2 M)

     
  Jeremy Podger   1 RICs   $28.09 million   3 PIVs, 1 other   None(g)     (14     (36
   

7 PIV

4 other accounts

 

$692.70 million

$120.63 million

  ($96.2 M)      

 

124


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate
Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation
 

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

  AllianceBernstein:            
  Kevin F. Simms   112 RICs   $38.41 billion   3 RICs ($6.56 B);      
  Henry S. D’Auria   195 PIVs   $19.99 billion   3 PIVs ($839 M);      
  Sharon E. Fay   33,923 other accounts   $96.14 billion   86 other ($8.82 B)      
  Marilyn G. Fedak   43 RICs   $11.20 billion   1 RIC ($3.64 B);   None     (16     (33
   

52 PIVs

33,271 other accounts

 

$1.43 billion

$23.54 billion

  8 other ($584 M)      
  Giulio Martini  

53 RICs

94 PIVs

548 other accounts

 

$23.88 billion

$17.06 billion

$58.71 billion

  2 RICs ($2.92 B);

2 PIVs ($792 M);

62 other ($6.79 B)

     
 

Mondrian:

           
  Ormala Krishnan   1 RIC   $363.0 million   None   None     (8     (34
   

1 PIV

11 other accounts

 

$406.0 million

$1.08 billion

       
 

Tradewinds:

           
  Peter Boardman   4 RICs   $1.80 billion   None   None     (11     (35
   

9 PIVs

41,851 other accounts

 

$906.79 million

$11.98 billion

       
  Alberto Jimenez Crespo  

4 RICs

9 PIVs

41,848 other accounts

 

$1.81 billion

$906.79 million

$11.85 billion

       

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

  Richard M. Parower  

3 RICs

5 PIVs

 

$3.40 billion

$904.02 million

    $100,001 –
$500,000
   
    6 other accounts   $247.29 million        
  Paul H. Wick  

3 RICs

5 PIVs

5 other accounts

 

$3.40 billion

$904.02 million

$246.94 million

    None    
  Reema D. Shah   3 RICs   $3.40 billion   None   None     (2     (30
   

5 PIVs

8 other accounts

 

$904.02 million

$253.02 million

       
  Ajay Diwan  

3 RICs

5 PIVs

7 other accounts

 

$3.40 billion

$904.02 million

$249.66 million

    None    
  Benjamin Lu  

1 RIC

2 PIVs

 

$6.11 million

$41.12 million

    $0 –

$10,000

   
    1 other account   $0.01 million        

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

  Fred Copper(k)   10 RICs   $1.8 billion   None   None     (3     (32
   

4 PIVs

24 other accounts

 

$634.7 million

$92.4 million

       

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

  Columbia WAM:            
  P. Zachary Egan   2 RICs   $4.10 billion   None   None     (15     (31
             
  Louis J. Mendes   3 RICs   $5.50 billion        

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

  Columbia WAM:            
  P. Zachary Egan   2 RICs   $4.30 billion   None   None     (15     (31
  Louis Mendes III   3 RICs   $5.60 billion        

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

  Threadneedle:            
  Stephen Thornber   2 RICs   $481.64 million   1 RIC ($481.64 M)   None(g)     (14     (36
   

3 PIVs

3 other accounts

 

$779.53 million

$411.64 million

       
  Jeremy Podger  

2 RICs

7 PIV

4 other accounts

 

$28.09 million

$144.71 million

$120.63 million

  3 PIVs, 1 other

($96.2 M)

     

Threadneedle International Opportunity

  Threadneedle:            
  Alex Lyle   1 RIC   $552.78 million   1 RIC ($552.78 M);   None(g)     (14     (36
   

16 PIVs

30 other accounts

 

$1.20 million

$2.17 billion

  1 other ($221.18 M)      
  Esther Perkins  

1 RIC

3 other accounts

 

$552.78 million

$264.31 million

  1 RIC ($552.78 M)      

 

125


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

    Ownership
of Fund
Shares
    Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
        Structure of
Compensation
 

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

         

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

  Catherine Stienstra   10 RICs   $3.82 billion     None        None        (2     (23
    11 other accounts   $6.50 billion        

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

  John K. Schonberg  

7 RICs

2 PIVs

6 other accounts

 

$745.93 million

$15.93 million

$1.12 million

       
  Sam Murphy   1 RIC   $364.11 million     1 RIC ($364.11 M)        None        (2     (37
    3 other accounts   $0.12 million        
  Mike Marzolf  

1 RIC

2 other accounts

 

$364.11 million

$0.05 million

       

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

  Brian M. McGreery(m)   7 RICs   $4.20 billion     None        None        (3     (32
    7 other accounts   $640.57 million        

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

  Kimberly Campbell(m)   7 RICs   $3.40 billion     None        None        (3     (32
    18 other accounts   $0.93 million        

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

         

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

  Neil Eigen   6 RICs   $642.93 million     4 RICs ($544.83 M)        None       
    2 PIVs   $149.17 million        
    65 other accounts(d)   $2.92 billion         (2     (22
  Richard Rosen   6 RICs   $642.93 million     4 RICs ($544.83 M)        None       
    2 PIVs   $149.17 million        
    70 other accounts(d)   $2.88 billion        

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

  Neil Eigen   6 RICs   $611.66 million     4 RICs ($513.56 M)        None       
    2 PIVs   $149.17 million        
    65 other accounts(d)   $2.92 billion         (2     (22
  Richard Rosen   6 RICs   $611.66 million     4 RICs ($513.56 M)        $1-$10,000       
    2 PIVs   $149.17 million        
    70 other accounts(d)   $2.88 billion        

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

  Paul Wick   4 RICs   $851.40 million     None        Over       
    5 PIVs   $1.82 billion       $1,000,000,000       
    6 other accounts   $266.43 million         (2     (30
  Ajay Diwan   4 RICs   $851.40 million     None        None       
    5 PIVs   $1.82 billion        
    7 other accounts   $262.94 million        
  Richard Parower   3 RICs   $566.53 million     None        None       
    5 PIVs   $1.82 billion        
    8 other accounts   $265.53 million        
  Reema Shah   3 RICs   $566.53 million     None        None       
    5 PIVs   $1.82 billion        
    8 other accounts   $270.30 million        
  Sangeeth Peruri   1 RIC   $56.04 million     None        None       
    3 PIVs   $874.60 million        
    9 other accounts   $16.67 million        

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

  LaSalle Securities:            
  Stan J. Kraska   2 RICs   $113.0 million     4 other accounts        $10,001- $50,000        (17     (39
    14 PIVs   $4.15 billion     ($539 M)         
    29 other accounts   $2.83 billion        
  George J. Noon   2 RICs   $113.0 million       None       
  Keith R. Pauley   14 PIVs   $4.15 billion       None       
    28 other accounts   $2.83 billion        
  Ernst Jan de Leeuw   1 RIC   $87.0 million     2 other accounts        None       
    16 PIVs   $4.20 billion     ($426 M)         
    17 other accounts   $1.31 billion        

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

  LaSalle Securities:            
  Stan J. Kraska   2 RICs   $101.0 million     4 other accounts        $10,001- $50,000        (17     (39
    14 PIVs   $4.15 billion     ($539 M)         
    29 other accounts   $2.83 billion        
  George J. Noon   2 RICs   $101.0 million       None       
  Keith R. Pauley   14 PIVs   $4.15 billion        
    28 other accounts   $2.83 billion       None       

 

126


Table of Contents

 

       

Other Accounts Managed (excluding the fund)

  Ownership
of Fund
Shares
  Potential
Conflicts
of Interest
       

Fund

 

Portfolio Manager

 

Number and Type
of Account*

 

Approximate

Total Net Assets

  Performance  Based
Accounts(a)
      Structure of
Compensation
 

Seligman Capital

  Wayne Collette(k)   10 RICs   $2.55 billion   None   None    
    1 PIV   $125.4 million        
    114 other accounts   $216.4 million        
  George Myers(k)   7 RICs   $2.13 billion   None   None    
    1 PIV   $125.4 million        
    103 other accounts   $138.8 million        
  Lawrence W. Lin(k)   7 RICs   $2.13 billion   None   None     (3     (32
    1 PIV   $125.4 million        
    108 other accounts   $138.8 million        
  Brian D. Neigut(k)   7 RICs   $2.13 billion   None   None    
    1 PIV   $125.4 million        
    105 other accounts   $138.6 million        

Seligman Growth

  John Wilson(k)   5 RICs   $1.65 billion   None   None    
    1 PIV   $310.0 million        
    19 other accounts   $350.0 million        
  Peter Deininger(k)   1 PIV   $315.0 million   None   None     (3     (32
    15 other accounts   $275.0 million        

 

* RIC refers to a Registered Investment Company; PIV refers to a Pooled Investment Vehicle.
(a) Number of accounts for which the advisory fee paid is based in part or wholly on performance and the aggregate net assets in those accounts.
(b) Mr. Bergene has overall accountability for the group that monitors the subadvisers for the funds and for making recommendations to the Boards of Directors on changes to those subadvisers.
(c) Mr. Truscott, who serves as Chairman of the Board for Columbia Management, oversees the portfolio managers who manage other accounts for Columbia Management, including the underlying funds in which the Funds-of-Funds invest, and other accounts managed by Columbia Management and its affiliates including institutional assets, proprietary assets and hedge funds.
(d) Reflects each wrap program strategy as a single client, rather than counting each participant in the program as a separate client.
(e) Wrap accounts have been counted at the sponsor level.
(f) Neither Christopher Davis nor Kenneth Feinberg own any shares of RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund. However, both portfolio managers have over $1 million invested in the Davis Funds, which are managed in a similar style.
(g) The fund is available for sale only in the U.S. The portfolio managers do not reside in the U.S. and therefore do not hold any shares of the fund.
(h) The portfolio manager began managing the fund after its last fiscal year end; reporting information is as of Oct. 31, 2008.
(i) The portfolio manager began managing the fund after its last fiscal year end; reporting information is provided as of Jan. 31, 2009.
(j) The portfolio manager began managing the fund after its last fiscal year end; reporting information is provided as of Dec. 31, 2009.
(k) The portfolio manager began managing the fund after its last fiscal year end; reporting information is provided as of March 31, 2010.
(l) The portfolio manager began managing the fund after its last fiscal year end; reporting information is provided as of April 30, 2010.
(m) The portfolio manager began managing the fund effective Oct. 1, 2010; reporting is provided as of Aug. 31, 2010.
(n) The portfolio manager began managing the fund effective Oct. 1, 2010; reporting is provided as of July 31, 2010.

Potential Conflicts of Interest

 

(1) Columbia Management: Management of funds-of-funds differs from that of the other funds. The portfolio management process is set forth generally below and in more detail in the funds’ prospectus.

Portfolio managers of the fund-of-funds may be involved in determining each funds-of-fund’s allocation among the three main asset classes (equity, fixed income and cash) and the allocation among investment categories within each asset class, as well as each funds-of-fund’s allocation among the underlying funds.

 

   

Because of the structure of the funds-of-funds, the potential conflicts of interest for the portfolio managers may be different than the potential conflicts of interest for portfolio managers who manage other funds.

In addition to the accounts above, portfolio managers may manage accounts in a personal capacity that may include holdings that are similar to, or the same as, those of the fund. The investment manager has in place a Code of Ethics that is designed to address conflicts and that, among other things, imposes restrictions on the ability of the portfolio managers and other “investment access persons” to invest in securities that may be recommended or traded in the fund and other client accounts.

 

(2)

Columbia Management: Portfolio managers may manage one or more mutual funds as well as other types of accounts, including hedge funds, proprietary accounts, separate accounts for institutions and individuals, and other pooled investment vehicles. Portfolio managers make investment decisions for an account or portfolio based on its investment objectives and policies, and other relevant investment considerations. A portfolio manager may manage another account whose fees may be materially greater than the management fees paid by the fund and may include a performance-based fee. Management of multiple funds and accounts may create potential conflicts of interest relating to the allocation of investment opportunities, competing investment decisions made for different accounts and the aggregation and allocation of trades. In addition, the investment manager monitors a variety of areas (e.g., allocation of investment

 

127


Table of Contents

opportunities) and compliance with the firm’s Code of Ethics, and places additional investment restrictions on portfolio managers who manage hedge funds and certain other accounts.

The investment manager has a fiduciary responsibility to all of the clients for which it manages accounts. The investment manager seeks to provide best execution of all securities transactions and to aggregate securities transactions and then allocate securities to client accounts in a fair and equitable basis over time. The investment manager has developed policies and procedures, including brokerage and trade allocation policies and procedures, designed to mitigate and manage the potential conflicts of interest that may arise from the management of multiple types of accounts for multiple clients.

In addition to the accounts above, portfolio managers may manage accounts in a personal capacity that may include holdings that are similar to, or the same as, those of the fund. The investment manager’s Code of Ethics is designed to address conflicts and, among other things, imposes restrictions on the ability of the portfolio managers and other “investment access persons” to invest in securities that may be recommended or traded in the fund and other client accounts.

For portfolio managers Marzolf and Murphy, their responsibilities also include working as a securities analyst. This dual role may give rise to conflicts with respect to making investment decisions for accounts that the portfolio manager manages versus communicating his or her analyses to other portfolio managers concerning securities that he or she follows as an analyst.

 

(3) Columbia Management: Like other investment professionals with multiple clients, a fund’s portfolio manager(s) may face certain potential conflicts of interest in connection with managing both the fund and other accounts at the same time. The investment manager and the funds have adopted compliance policies and procedures that attempt to address certain of the potential conflicts that portfolio managers face in this regard. Certain of these conflicts of interest are summarized below.

The management of accounts with different advisory fee rates and/or fee structures, including accounts that pay advisory fees based on account performance (performance fee accounts), may raise potential conflicts of interest for a portfolio manager by creating an incentive to favor higher fee accounts.

Potential conflicts of interest also may arise when a portfolio manager has personal investments in other accounts that may create an incentive to favor those accounts. As a general matter and subject to the investment manager’s Code of Ethics and certain limited exceptions, the investment manager’s investment professionals do not have the opportunity to invest in client accounts, other than the funds.

A portfolio manager who is responsible for managing multiple funds and/or accounts may devote unequal time and attention to the management of those funds and/or accounts. The effects of this potential conflict may be more pronounced where funds and/or accounts managed by a particular portfolio manager have different investment strategies.

A portfolio manager may be able to select or influence the selection of the broker/dealers that are used to execute securities transactions for the funds. A portfolio manager’s decision as to the selection of broker/dealers could produce disproportionate costs and benefits among the funds and the other accounts the portfolio manager manages.

A potential conflict of interest may arise when a portfolio manager buys or sells the same securities for a fund and other accounts. On occasions when a portfolio manager considers the purchase or sale of a security to be in the best interests of a fund as well as other accounts, the investment manager’s trading desk may, to the extent consistent with applicable laws and regulations, aggregate the securities to be sold or bought in order to obtain the best execution and lower brokerage commissions, if any. Aggregation of trades may create the potential for unfairness to a fund or another account if a portfolio manager favors one account over another in allocating the securities bought or sold.

“Cross trades,” in which a portfolio manager sells a particular security held by a fund to another account (potentially saving transaction costs for both accounts), could involve a potential conflict of interest if, for example, a portfolio manager is permitted to sell a security from one account to another account at a higher price than an independent third party would pay. The investment manager and the funds have adopted compliance procedures that provide that any transactions between a fund and another account managed by the investment manager are to be made at a current market price, consistent with applicable laws and regulations.

Another potential conflict of interest may arise based on the different investment objectives and strategies of a fund and other accounts managed by its portfolio manager(s). Depending on another account’s objectives and other factors, a portfolio manager may give advice to and make decisions for a fund that may differ from advice given, or the timing or nature of decisions made, with respect to another account. A portfolio manager’s investment decisions are the product of many factors in addition to basic suitability for the particular account involved. Thus, a portfolio manager may buy or sell a particular security for certain accounts, and not for a fund, even though it could have been bought or sold for

 

128


Table of Contents

 

the fund at the same time. A portfolio manager also may buy a particular security for one or more accounts when one or more other accounts are selling the security (including short sales). There may be circumstances when a portfolio manager’s purchases or sales of portfolio securities for one or more accounts may have an adverse effect on other accounts, including the funds.

A fund’s portfolio manager(s) also may have other potential conflicts of interest in managing the fund, and the description above is not a complete description of every conflict that could exist in managing the fund and other accounts. Many of the potential conflicts of interest to which the investment manager’s portfolio managers are subject are essentially the same or similar to the potential conflicts of interest related to the investment management activities of the investment manager and its affiliates.

 

(4) Turner: As is typical for many money managers, potential conflicts of interest may arise related to Turner’s management of accounts including the fund where not all accounts are able to participate in a desired IPO, or other limited opportunity, relating to use of soft dollars and other brokerage practices, related to the voting of proxies, employee personal securities trading, and relating to a variety of other circumstances. In all cases, however, Turner believes it has written policies and procedures in place reasonably designed to prevent violations of the federal securities laws and to prevent material conflicts of interest from arising. Please also see Turner’s Form ADV, Part II for a description of some of its policies and procedures in this regard.

 

(5) MDTA: As a general matter, certain conflicts of interest may arise in connection with a portfolio manager’s management of a fund’s investments, on the one hand, and the investments of other accounts for which the portfolio manager is responsible, on the other. For example, it is possible that the various accounts managed could have different investment strategies that, at times, might conflict with one another to the possible detriment of the Fund. Alternatively, to the extent that the same investment opportunities might be desirable for more than one account, possible conflicts could arise in determining how to allocate them. Other potential conflicts might include conflicts created by specific portfolio manager compensation arrangements, and conflicts relating to selection of brokers or dealers to execute fund portfolio trades and/or specific uses of commissions from Fund portfolio trades (for example, research, or “soft dollars”). The Adviser has structured the portfolio managers’ compensation in a manner, and the Fund has adopted policies and procedures, reasonably designed to safeguard the Fund from being negatively affected as a result of any such potential conflicts.

 

(6) Columbia Management: Management of the Income Builder Funds-of-Funds differs from that of the other funds. The portfolio management process is set forth generally below and in more detail in the funds’ prospectus.

The investment manager uses quantitative models combined with qualitative factors to determine the funds allocations to the underlying funds. Using these methodologies, a group of the investment manager’s investment professionals allocates each fund’s assets within and across different asset classes in an effort to achieve the fund’s objective of providing a high level of current income and growth of capital. The fund will typically be rebalanced monthly in an effort to maximize the level of income and capital growth, incorporating various measures of relative value subject to constraints that set minimum or maximum exposure within asset classes, as set forth in the prospectus. Within the equity and fixed income asset classes, the investment manager establishes allocations for the funds, seeking to achieve each fund’s objective by investing in defined investment categories. The target allocation range constraints are intended, in part, to promote diversification within the asset classes.

Because of the structure of the funds-of-funds, the potential conflicts of interest for the portfolio managers may be different than the potential conflicts of interest for portfolio managers who manage other funds. These potential conflicts of interest include:

 

   

In certain cases, the portfolio managers of the underlying funds are the same as the portfolio managers of the Income Builder Funds-of-Funds, and could influence the allocation of funds-of-funds assets to or away from the underlying funds that they manage.

 

   

The investment manager and its affiliates may receive higher compensation as a result of allocations to underlying funds with higher fees.

The investment manager monitors the performance of the underlying funds and may, from time to time, recommend to the Board of Directors of the funds a change in portfolio management or fund strategy or the closure or merger of an underlying fund. In addition, the investment manager may believe that certain funds may benefit from additional assets or could be harmed by redemptions. All of these factors may also influence decisions in connection with the allocation of funds-of-funds assets to or away from certain underlying funds.

In addition to the accounts above, portfolio managers may manage accounts in a personal capacity that may include holdings that are similar to, or the same as, those of the fund. The investment manager has in place a Code of Ethics that is designed to address conflicts and that, among other things, imposes restrictions on the ability of the portfolio

 

129


Table of Contents

managers and other “investment access persons” to invest in securities that may be recommended or traded in the fund and other client accounts.

 

(7) American Century: Certain conflicts of interest may arise in connection with the management of multiple portfolios. Potential conflicts include, for example, conflicts among investment strategies and conflicts in the allocation of investment opportunities. American Century has adopted policies and procedures that are designed to minimize the effects of these conflicts.

Responsibility for managing American Century client portfolios is organized according to investment discipline. Investment disciplines include, for example, quantitative equity, small- and mid-cap growth, large-cap growth, value, international, fixed income, asset allocation, and sector funds. Within each discipline are one or more portfolio teams responsible for managing specific client portfolios. Generally, client portfolios with similar strategies are managed by the same team using the same objective, approach, and philosophy. Accordingly, portfolio holdings, position sizes, and industry and sector exposures tend to be similar across similar portfolios, which minimizes the potential for conflicts of interest.

For each investment strategy, one portfolio is generally designated as the “policy portfolio.” Other portfolios with similar investment objectives, guidelines and restrictions are referred to as “tracking portfolios.” When managing policy and tracking portfolios, a portfolio team typically purchases and sells securities across all portfolios that the team manages. American Century’s trading systems include various order entry programs that assist in the management of multiple portfolios, such as the ability to purchase or sell the same relative amount of one security across several funds. In some cases a tracking portfolio may have additional restrictions or limitations that cause it to be managed separately from the policy portfolio. Portfolio managers make purchase and sale decisions for such portfolios alongside the policy portfolio to the extent the overlap is appropriate, and separately, if the overlap is not.

American Century may aggregate orders to purchase or sell the same security for multiple portfolios when it believes such aggregation is consistent with its duty to seek best execution on behalf of its clients. Orders of certain client portfolios may, by investment restriction or otherwise, be determined not available for aggregation. American Century has adopted policies and procedures to minimize the risk that a client portfolio could be systematically advantaged or disadvantaged in connection with the aggregation of orders. To the extent equity trades are aggregated, shares purchased or sold are generally allocated to the participating portfolios pro rata based on order size. Because initial public offerings (IPOs) are usually available in limited supply and in amounts too small to permit across-the-board pro rata allocations, American Century has adopted special procedures designed to promote a fair and equitable allocation of IPO securities among clients over time. Fixed income securities transactions are not executed through a centralized trading desk. Instead, portfolio teams are responsible for executing trades with broker/dealers in a predominantly dealer marketplace. Trade allocation decisions are made by the portfolio manager at the time of trade execution and orders entered on the fixed income order management system.

Finally, investment of American Century’s corporate assets in proprietary accounts may raise additional conflicts of interest. To mitigate these potential conflicts of interest, American Century has adopted policies and procedures intended to provide that trading in proprietary accounts is performed in a manner that does not give improper advantage to American Century to the detriment of client portfolios.

 

(8) Mondrian: Mondrian does not foresee any material conflicts of interest that may arise in the management of the funds and any other accounts managed with similar investment guidelines. Mondrian acts solely as an investment manager and does not engage in any other business activities. The following is a list of some potential conflicts of interest that can arise in the course of normal investment management business activities. Mondrian maintains and operates various policies and procedures which are designed to prevent or manage any of the conflicts identified below so that the interests of its clients are always put ahead of Mondrian’s own interests or those of its employees and directors:

Allocation of aggregated trades

Mondrian may from time to time aggregate trades for a number of its clients.

Mondrian’s policy requires that all allocations of aggregated trades must be fair between clients. Transactions involving commingled orders are allocated in a manner deemed equitable to each account. When a combined order is executed in a series of transactions, at different prices, each account participating in the order may be allocated an average price obtained from the broker/dealer. When a trade can be allocated in a cost efficient manner to our clients, it will be prorated across all participating accounts. Mondrian may randomly allocate purchases or sales among participating accounts when the amounts involved are too small to be evenly proportioned in a cost efficient manner. In performing random allocations, Mondrian will consider consistency of strategy implementation among participating accounts.

 

130


Table of Contents

 

Allocation of investment opportunities

Mondrian is an investment manager of multiple client portfolios. As such, it has to ensure that investment opportunities are allocated fairly between clients. There is a potential risk that Mondrian may favor one client over another client in making allocations of investment opportunities.

Mondrian makes security selection decisions at committee level. Those securities identified as investment opportunities are added to a list of approved securities; portfolios will hold only such approved securities.

All portfolios governed by the same or a similar mandate will be structured similarly (that is, will hold the same or comparable stocks), and will exhibit similar characteristics. Sale and purchase opportunities identified at regular investment meetings will be applied to portfolios across the board, subject to the requirements of individual client mandates.

See also “Side-by-side management of hedge funds” below.

Allocation of IPO opportunities

Initial Public Offerings (“IPO’s”) present a potential conflict of interest when they are priced at a discount to the anticipated secondary market price and the issuer has restricted or scaled back its allocation due to market demand. In such instances, the IPO allocation could be divided among a small select group of clients with others not receiving the allocation they would otherwise be entitled to.

Mondrian clients with relevant mandates are given an equal opportunity, proportionate to the size of their portfolio, to participate in IPO trades. All IPO purchases are allocated on a strict pro-rata basis.

Dealing in investments as principal in connections with the provision of seed capital

A conflict of interest exists when a portfolio management firm manages its own money alongside client money.

Mondrian generally does not trade for its own account. However, Mondrian and its affiliates have provided the seed capital to certain investment vehicles that have been established by Mondrian group entities. Mondrian serves as the investment manager to these investment vehicles.

Mondrian operates dealing policies designed to ensure the fair and equal treatment of all clients e.g. the allocation of aggregated trades among clients. These policies ensure that any portfolios in which Mondrian has an investment interest do not receive favorable treatment relative to other client portfolios.

Directorships and external arrangements

Certain Mondrian staff may hold positions in external organizations. There is a potential risk that Mondrian personnel may place their own interests (resulting from outside employment/directorships) ahead of the interests of Mondrian clients.

Before accepting an executive or non-executive directorship or any other appointment in another company, employees, including executive directors, must obtain the prior approval of the Chief Executive Officer. The Chief Compliance Officer must also be informed of all such appointments and changes.

The CEO and CCO will only permit appointments that would not present a conflict of interest with the individual’s responsibilities to Mondrian clients.

Dual agency

Dual Agency (also known as Cross Trading) concerns those transactions where Mondrian may act as agent for both the buyer and seller. In such circumstances there is a potential conflict of interest as it may be possible to favor one client over another when establishing the execution price and/or commission rate.

Although it rarely does so, Mondrian may act as agent for both buying and selling parties with respect to transactions in investments. If Mondrian proposes to act in such capacity, the Portfolio Manager will first obtain approval from the Chief Compliance Officer. The CCO has an obligation to ensure that both parties are treated fairly in any such trade.

Employee personal account dealing

There are a number of potential conflicts when staff of an investment firm engage in buying and selling securities for their personal account.

Mondrian has arrangements in place to ensure that none of its directors, officers or employees (or persons connected to them by way of a business or domestic relationship) effects any transaction on their own account which conflicts with client interests.

Mondrian’s rules which govern personal account dealing and general ethical standards are set out in the Mondrian Investment Partners Code of Ethics.

 

131


Table of Contents

 

Gifts and entertainment (received)

In the normal course of business Mondrian employees may receive gifts and entertainment from third parties e.g. brokers and other service providers. This results in a potential conflict of interest when selecting third parties to provide services to Mondrian and its clients.

Mondrian has a policy which requires that gifts and entertainment received are reported to the Chief Compliance Officer (any items in excess of £100 require pre-approval).

All gifts and entertainment are reviewed to ensure that they are not inappropriate and that staff have not been unduly influenced by them.

Gifts and entertainment (given)

In the normal course of business, Mondrian employees may provide gifts and entertainment to third parties. Excessively lavish gifts and entertainment would be inappropriate.

Mondrian has a policy which requires that any gifts and entertainment provided are reported to the Chief Compliance Officer (any items in excess of £200 require pre-approval).

All gifts and entertainment are reviewed to ensure that they are not inappropriate and that staff have not attempted to obtain undue influence from them.

Performance fees

Where an investment firm has clients with a performance fee arrangement there is a risk that those clients could be favored over clients without performance fees.

Mondrian charges fees as a proportion of assets under management. In a very limited number of situations, in addition to this fee basis, certain accounts also include a performance fee basis.

The potential conflict of interest arising from these fee arrangements is addressed by Mondrian’s procedures for the allocation of aggregated trades among clients. Investment opportunities are allocated totally independently of fee arrangements.

Side-by-side management of hedge funds (Mondrian Alpha Funds)

Where an investment manager has responsibility for managing long only portfolios alongside portfolios that can take short positions there is potential for a conflict of interest to arise between the two types of portfolio.

Mondrian acts as investment manager for two Fixed Income Alpha and one Equity Alpha fund. The Alpha Funds are permitted to take short positions and are also permitted to invest in some or all of the same securities that Mondrian manages for other clients.

Mondrian is satisfied that the investment styles of these different products significantly reduce the likelihood of a conflict of interest arising. However, Mondrian has a number of policies and procedures in place that are designed to ensure that any potential conflicts are correctly managed and monitored so that all clients are treated fairly.

Soft dollar arrangements

Where an investment manager has soft dollar arrangements in place with a broker/dealer there is a potential conflict of interest as trading volumes through that broker/dealer are usually important in ensuring that soft dollar targets are met.

As is typical in the investment management industry, Mondrian client funds are used to pay brokerage commissions for the execution of transactions in the client’s portfolio. As part of that execution service, brokers generally provide proprietary research to their clients as to the value of securities, the advisability of investing in, purchasing or selling securities, and the availability of securities or purchasers or sellers of securities; furnishing of analyses and reports concerning issuers, securities or industries; and providing information on economic factors and trends.

Proprietary research may be used by Mondrian in connection with its investment decision-making process with respect to one or more accounts managed by it, and it may or may not be used, or used exclusively, with respect to the account generating the brokerage.

With the exception of the receipt of proprietary research, Mondrian has no other soft dollar or commission sharing arrangements in place with brokers.

 

(9) Davis: Actual or apparent conflicts of interest may arise when a portfolio manager has day-to-day management responsibilities with respect to more than one portfolio or other account. More specifically, portfolio managers who manage multiple portfolios and/or other accounts are presented with the following potential conflicts:

 

   

The management of multiple portfolios and/or other accounts may result in a portfolio manager devoting unequal time and attention to the management of each portfolio and/or other account. Davis Advisors seeks to manage such competing interests for the time and attention of portfolio managers by having portfolio managers focus on a particular investment discipline. Most other accounts managed by a portfolio manager are managed using the same investment models that are used in connection with the management of the portfolios.

 

132


Table of Contents

 

   

If a portfolio manager identifies a limited investment opportunity which may be suitable for more than one portfolio or other account, a portfolio may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of filled purchase or sale orders across all eligible portfolios and other accounts. To deal with these situations, Davis Advisors has adopted procedures for allocating portfolio transactions across multiple accounts.

 

   

With respect to securities transactions for the portfolios, Davis Advisors determines which broker to use to execute each order, consistent with its duty to seek best execution of the transaction. However, with respect to certain other accounts (such as mutual funds, other pooled investment vehicles that are not registered mutual funds, and other accounts managed for organizations and individuals), Davis Advisors may be limited by the client with respect to the selection of brokers or may be instructed to direct trades through a particular broker. In these cases, Davis Advisors may place separate, non-simultaneous, transactions for a portfolio and another account which may temporarily affect the market price of the security or the execution of the transaction, or both, to the detriment of the portfolio or the other account.

 

   

Finally, substantial investment of Davis Advisor or Davis Family assets in certain mutual funds may lead to conflicts of interest. To mitigate these potential conflicts of interest, Davis Advisors has adopted policies and procedures intended to ensure that all clients are treated fairly over time. Davis Advisors does not receive an incentive based fee on any account.

 

(10) Donald Smith: Donald Smith & Co., Inc. is very sensitive to conflicts of interest that could possibly arise in its capacity of serving as an investment adviser. It remains committed to resolving any and all conflicts in the best interest of its clients.

Donald Smith & Co., Inc. is an independent investment advisor with no parent or subsidiary organizations. Additionally, it has no affiliated organizations, brokerage, nor any investment banking activities.

Clients include mutual funds, public and corporate pension plans, endowments and foundations, and other separate accounts. Donald Smith & Co., Inc. has put in place systems, policies and procedures, which have been designed to maintain fairness in portfolio management across all clients. Potential conflicts between funds or with other types of accounts are managed via allocation policies and procedures, internal review processes, and direct oversight by Donald G. Smith, President.

 

(11) Tradewinds: Actual or apparent conflicts of interest may arise when a portfolio manager has day-to-day management responsibilities with respect to more than one account. More specifically, portfolio managers who manage multiple accounts are presented with several potential conflicts, which is not intended to be an exhaustive list:

 

   

The management of multiple accounts may result in a portfolio manager devoting unequal time and attention to the management of each account. Tradewinds seeks to manage such competing interests for the time and attention of portfolio managers by having portfolio managers focus on a particular investment discipline. Most accounts managed by a portfolio manager in a particular investment strategy are managed using the same investment models.

 

   

If a portfolio manager identifies a limited investment opportunity which may be suitable for more than one account, an account may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of filled purchase or sale orders across all eligible accounts. To deal with these situations, Tradewinds has adopted procedures for fairly allocating portfolio transactions across multiple accounts.

 

   

With respect to many of its clients’ accounts, Tradewinds determines which broker to use to execute transaction orders, consistent with its duty to seek best execution of the transaction. However, with respect to certain other accounts, Tradewinds may be limited by the client with respect to the selection of brokers or may be instructed to direct trades through a particular broker. In these cases, Tradewinds may place separate, non-simultaneous, transactions for a Fund and other accounts which may temporarily affect the market price of the security or the execution of the transaction, or both, to the detriment of the Fund or the other accounts.

 

   

Some clients are subject to different regulations. As a consequence of this difference in regulatory requirements, some clients may not be permitted to engage in all the investment techniques or transactions or to engage in these transactions to the same extent as the other accounts managed by the portfolio manager. Finally, the appearance of a conflict of interest may arise where Tradewinds has an incentive, such as a performance-based management fee, which relates to the management of some accounts, with respect to which a portfolio manager has day-to-day management responsibilities.

Tradewinds has adopted certain compliance procedures which are designed to address these types of conflicts common among investment managers. However, there is no guarantee that such procedures will detect each and every situation in which a conflict arises.

 

(12)

BHMS: Actual or potential conflicts of interest may arise when a portfolio manager has management responsibilities to more than one account (including the Fund). BHMS manages potential conflicts between funds or with other types of accounts through allocation policies and procedures, internal review processes and oversight by directors and

 

133


Table of Contents
 

independent third parties to ensure that no client, regardless of type or fee structure, is intentionally favored at the expense of another. Allocation policies are designed to address potential conflicts in situations where two or more funds or accounts participate in investment decisions involving the same securities.

 

(13) MetWest: MetWest Capital’s portfolio managers generally face two types of conflicts of interest: (1) conflicts between and among the interests of the various accounts they manage, and (2) conflicts between the interests of the accounts they manage and their own personal interests. The policies of MetWest Capital require that portfolio managers treat all accounts they manage equitably and fairly in the face of such real or potential conflicts, The management of multiple funds and other accounts may require the portfolio manager to devote less than all of his or her time to a fund, particularly if the funds and accounts have different objectives, benchmarks and time horizons. The portfolio manager may also be required to allocate his or her investment ideas across multiple funds and accounts. In addition, if a portfolio manager identifies a limited investment opportunity, such as an IPO that may be suitable for more than one fund or other account, a fund may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of that investment across all eligible funds and accounts. Further, security purchase and sale orders for multiple accounts often are aggregated for purpose of execution. Although such aggregation generally benefits clients, it may cause the price or brokerage costs to be less favorable to a particular client than if similar transactions were not being executed concurrently for other accounts. It may also happen that a fund’s adviser or sub-adviser will determine that it would be in the best interest, and consistent with the investment policies, of another account to sell a security (including by means of a short sale) that a fund holds long, potentially resulting in a decrease in the market value of the security held by the fund.

As noted above, portfolio managers may also experience certain conflicts between the interests of the accounts they manage and their own personal interests (which may include interests in advantaging MetWest Capital). The structure of a portfolio manager’s or an investment advisor’s compensation may create an incentive for the manager or advisor to favor accounts whose performance has a greater impact on such compensation. The portfolio manager may, for example, have an incentive to allocate favorable or limited opportunity investments or structure the timing of investments to favor such accounts. Similarly, if a portfolio manager holds a larger personal investment in one fund than he or she does in another, the portfolio manager may have an incentive to favor the fund in which he or she holds a larger stake. In general, MetWest Capital has policies and procedures to address the various potential conflicts of interest described above. It has policies and procedures designed to ensure that portfolio managers have sufficient time and resources to devote to the various accounts they manage. Similarly, it has policies and procedures designed to ensure that investments and investment opportunities are allocated fairly across accounts, and that the interests of client accounts are placed ahead of a portfolio manager’s personal interests. However, there is no guarantee that such procedures will detect or address each and every situation where a conflict arises.

 

(14) Threadneedle: Threadneedle Investments portfolio managers may manage one or more mutual funds as well as other types of accounts, including proprietary accounts, separate accounts for institutions, and other pooled investment vehicles. Portfolio managers make investment decisions for an account or portfolio based on its investment objectives and policies, and other relevant investment considerations. A portfolio manager may manage a separate account or other pooled investment vehicle whose fees may be materially greater than the management fees paid by the Fund and may include a performance-based fee. Management of multiple funds and accounts may create potential conflicts of interest relating to the allocation of investment opportunities, and the aggregation and allocation of trades. In addition, the portfolio manager’s responsibilities at Threadneedle Investments include working as a securities analyst. This dual role may give rise to conflicts with respect to making investment decisions for accounts that he/she manages versus communicating his/her analyses to other portfolio managers concerning securities that he/she follows as an analyst.

Threadneedle Investments has a fiduciary responsibility to all of the clients for which it manages accounts. Threadneedle Investments seeks to provide best execution of all securities transactions and to aggregate securities transactions and then allocate securities to client accounts in a fair and timely manner. Threadneedle Investments has developed policies and procedures, including brokerage and trade allocation policies and procedures, designed to mitigate and manage the potential conflicts of interest that may arise from the management of multiple types of accounts for multiple clients.

 

(15) Columbia WAM: Like other investment professionals with multiple clients, a Fund’s portfolio manager(s) may face certain potential conflicts of interest in connection with managing both the Fund and other accounts at the same time. The Advisor (Columbia Wanger Asset Management) and the Funds have adopted compliance policies and procedures that attempt to address certain of the potential conflicts that portfolio managers face in this regard. Certain of these conflicts of interest are summarized below.

The management of accounts with different advisory fee rates and/or fee structures, including accounts that pay advisory fees based on account performance (performance fee accounts), if any, may raise potential conflicts of interest for a portfolio manager by creating an incentive to favor higher fee accounts.

 

134


Table of Contents

 

Potential conflicts of interest also may arise when a portfolio manager has personal investments in other accounts that may create an incentive to favor those accounts. As a general matter and subject to the Advisor’s Code of Ethics and certain limited exceptions, the Advisor’s investment professionals do not have the opportunity to invest in client accounts, other than the Funds.

A portfolio manager who is responsible for managing multiple funds and/or accounts may devote unequal time and attention to the management of those funds and/or accounts. The effects of this potential conflict may be more pronounced where funds and/or accounts managed by a particular portfolio manager have different investment strategies.

A portfolio manager may be able to select or influence the selection of the broker/dealers that are used to execute securities transactions for the Funds. A portfolio manager’s decision as to the selection of broker/dealers could produce disproportionate costs and benefits among the Funds and the other accounts the portfolio manager manages.

A potential conflict of interest may arise when a portfolio manager buys or sells the same securities for a Fund and other accounts. On occasions when a portfolio manager considers the purchase or sale of a security to be in the best interests of a Fund as well as other accounts, the Advisor’s trading desk may, to the extent consistent with applicable laws and regulations, aggregate the securities to be sold or bought in order to obtain the best execution and lower brokerage commissions, if any. Aggregation of trades may create the potential for unfairness to a Fund or another account if a portfolio manager favors one account over another in allocating the securities bought or sold.

“Cross trades,” in which a portfolio manager sells a particular security held by a Fund to another account (potentially saving transaction costs for both accounts), could involve a potential conflict of interest if, for example, a portfolio manager is permitted to sell a security from one account to another account at a higher price than an independent third party would pay. The Advisor and the Funds have adopted compliance procedures that provide that any transactions between the Fund and another account managed by the Advisor are to be made at an independent current market price, consistent with applicable laws and regulation.

Another potential conflict of interest may arise based on the different investment objectives and strategies of a Fund and other accounts managed by its portfolio manager(s). Depending on another account’s objectives and other factors, a portfolio manager may give advice to and make decisions for a Fund that may differ from advice given, or the timing or nature of decisions made, with respect to another account. A portfolio manager’s investment decisions are the product of many factors in addition to basic suitability for the particular account involved. Thus, a portfolio manager may buy or sell a particular security for certain accounts, and not for a Fund, even though it could have been bought or sold for the Fund at the same time. A portfolio manager also may buy a particular security for one or more accounts when one or more other accounts are selling the security (including short sales). There may be circumstances when a portfolio manager’s purchases or sales of portfolio securities for one or more accounts may have an adverse effect on other accounts, including the Funds.

A Fund’s portfolio manager(s) also may have other potential conflicts of interest in managing the Fund, and the description above is not a complete description of every conflict that could be deemed to exist in managing both the Fund and other accounts. Many of the potential conflicts of interest to which the Advisor’s portfolio managers are subject are essentially the same as or similar to the potential conflicts of interest related to the investment management activities of the Advisor and its affiliates.

 

(16) AllianceBernstein: As an investment adviser and fiduciary, AllianceBernstein owes its clients and shareholders an undivided duty of loyalty. We recognize that conflicts of interest are inherent in our business and accordingly have developed policies and procedures (including oversight monitoring) reasonably designed to detect, manage and mitigate the effects of actual or potential conflicts of interest in the area of employee personal trading, managing multiple accounts for multiple clients, including AllianceBernstein Mutual Funds, and allocating investment opportunities. Investment professionals, including portfolio managers and research analysts, are subject to the above-mentioned policies and oversight monitoring to ensure that all clients are treated equitably. We place the interests of our clients first and expect all of our employees to meet their fiduciary duties.

Employee Personal Trading

AllianceBernstein has adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics that is designed to detect and prevent conflicts of interest when investment professionals and other personnel of AllianceBernstein own, buy or sell securities which may be owned by, or bought or sold for, clients. Personal securities transactions by an employee may raise a potential conflict of interest when an employee owns or trades in a security that is owned or considered for purchase or sale by a client, or recommended for purchase or sale by an employee to a client. Subject to the reporting requirements and other limitations of its Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, AllianceBernstein permits its employees to engage in personal securities transactions, and also allows them to acquire investments in the AllianceBernstein Mutual Funds through

 

135


Table of Contents

direct purchase, 401K/profit sharing plan investment and/or notionally in connection with deferred incentive compensation awards. AllianceBernstein’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct requires disclosure of all personal accounts and maintenance of brokerage accounts with designated broker-dealers approved by AllianceBernstein. The Code also requires preclearance of all securities transactions and imposes a 90 day holding period for securities purchased by employees to discourage short-term trading.

Managing Multiple Accounts for Multiple Clients

AllianceBernstein has compliance policies and oversight monitoring in place to address conflicts of interest relating to the management of multiple accounts for multiple clients. Conflicts of interest may arise when an investment professional has responsibilities for the investments of more than one account because the investment professional may be unable to devote equal time and attention to each account. The investment professional or investment professional teams for each client may have responsibilities for managing all or a portion of the investments of multiple accounts with a common investment strategy, including other registered investment companies, unregistered investment vehicles, such as hedge funds, pension plans, separate accounts, collective trusts and charitable foundations. Among other things, AllianceBernstein’s policies and procedures provide for the prompt dissemination to investment professionals of initial or changed investment recommendations by analysts so that investment professionals are better able to develop investment strategies for all accounts they manage. In addition, investment decisions by investment professionals are reviewed for the purpose of maintaining uniformity among similar accounts and ensuring that accounts are treated equitably. No investment professional that manages client accounts carrying performance fees is compensated directly or specifically for the performance of those accounts. Investment professional compensation reflects a broad contribution in multiple dimensions to long-term investment success for our clients and is not tied specifically to the performance of any particular client’s account, nor is it directly tied to the level or change in the level of assets under management.

Allocating Investment Opportunities

AllianceBernstein has policies and procedures intended to address conflicts of interest relating to the allocation of investment opportunities. These policies and procedures are designed to ensure that information relevant to investment decisions is disseminated promptly within its portfolio management teams and investment opportunities are allocated equitably among different clients. The investment professionals at AllianceBernstein routinely are required to select and allocate investment opportunities among accounts. Portfolio holdings, position sizes, and industry and sector exposures tend to be similar across similar accounts, which minimizes the potential for conflicts of interest relating to the allocation of investment opportunities. Nevertheless, investment opportunities may be allocated differently among accounts due to the particular characteristics of an account, such as size of the account, cash position, tax status, risk tolerance and investment restrictions or for other reasons.

AllianceBernstein’s procedures are also designed to prevent potential conflicts of interest that may arise when AllianceBernstein has a particular financial incentive, such as a performance-based management fee, relating to an account. An investment professional may perceive that he or she has an incentive to devote more time to developing and analyzing investment strategies and opportunities or allocating securities preferentially to accounts for which AllianceBernstein could share in investment gains.

To address these conflicts of interest, AllianceBernstein’s policies and procedures require, among other things, the prompt dissemination to investment professionals of any initial or changed investment recommendations by analysts; the aggregation of orders to facilitate best execution for all accounts; price averaging for all aggregated orders; objective allocation for limited investment opportunities (e.g., on a rotational basis) to ensure fair and equitable allocation among accounts; and limitations on short sales of securities. These procedures also require documentation and review of justifications for any decisions to make investments only for select accounts or in a manner disproportionate to the size of the account.

 

(17) LaSalle: Since the Investment Team manages other accounts in addition to the Funds, conflicts of interest may arise in connection with the Investment Team’s management of a Fund’s investments on the one hand and the investments of such other accounts on the other hand. Conflicts may arise related to: (1) aggregation and allocation of securities transactions (including initial public offerings), (2) the timing of purchases and sales of the same security for different accounts and (3) different advice for different accounts, primarily driven by the account’s investment objectives. LaSalle Securities US and LaSalle Securities B.V. believe that conflicts are largely mitigated by their respective Code of Ethics, which prohibits ownership by the Investment Team Members (except through a mutual fund) of securities of the type the Funds invest in, and various policies and procedures it has adopted, including the master trading schedule it maintains to proportionately allocate purchases and sales to each account by tracking the target weight for each holding and establishing the required shares to reach those targets.

 

136


Table of Contents

 

Structure of Compensation

 

(18) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, and (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus and equity incentive awards are paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. Funding for the bonus pool is determined by a percentage of the aggregate assets under management in the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, including the fund, and by the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year, five-year and ten-year) performance of those accounts in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Funding for the bonus pool would also include a percentage of any performance fees earned on long/short mutual funds managed by the Team. With respect to hedge funds and separately managed accounts that follow a hedge fund mandate, funding for the bonus pool is a percentage of performance fees earned on the hedge funds or accounts managed by the portfolio managers. Senior management of Columbia Management has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. In addition, where portfolio managers invest in a hedge fund managed by the investment manager, they receive a cash reimbursement for the investment management fees charged on their hedge fund investments. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Columbia Management employees. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Columbia Management employees at the same job level.

 

(19) Columbia Management: The compensation of employees of the investment manager consists of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, and (iii) equity incentive awards in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus is based on management’s assessment of the employee’s performance relative to individual and business unit goals and objectives which, for portfolio manager Joy, may be based, in part, on achieving certain investment performance goals and retaining and attracting assets under management, and for portfolio manager Bergene, on developing competitive products, managing existing products, and selecting and monitoring subadvisers for the funds. In addition, subject to certain vesting requirements, the compensation of portfolio manager Joy includes an annual award based on the performance of Ameriprise Financial over rolling three-year periods. This program has been discontinued and the final award under this plan covers the three-year period that started in January 2007 and ended in December 2009. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefit package including life insurance, health insurance and participation in the company’s 401(k) plan comparable to that received by other employees of the investment manager. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all employees of investment manager at the same job level.

 

(20) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, and (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus and equity incentive awards are paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by a percentage of the aggregate assets under management in the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, including the fund, plus, where applicable, a percentage of the assets of the funds they support as research analysts, and by the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year and five-year) performance of those accounts in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Funding for the bonus pool may also include a percentage of any performance fees earned on long/short mutual funds managed by the Team. One member of the team does not participate in the pool but instead receives a bonus based on management fees on one product and asset retention efforts associated with other products managed by the team. Senior management of the investment manager has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other employees of the investment manager. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all employees of the investment manager at the same job level.

 

(21)

Turner: Turner’s investment professionals receive a base salary commensurate with their level of experience. Turner’s goal is to maintain competitive base salaries through review of industry standards, market conditions, and salary

 

137


Table of Contents
 

surveys. Bonus compensation, which is a multiple of base salary, is based on the performance of each individual’s sector and portfolio assignments relative to appropriate market benchmarks. In addition, each employee is eligible for equity awards. Turner believes this compensation provides incentive to attract and retain highly qualified people.

The objective performance criteria noted above accounts for 90% of the bonus calculation. The remaining 10% is based upon subjective, “good will” factors including teamwork, interpersonal relations, the individual’s contribution to overall success of the firm, media and client relations, presentation skills, and professional development. Portfolio managers/analysts are reviewed on an annual basis. The Chief Investment Officer, Robert E. Turner, CFA, is responsible for setting base salaries, bonus targets, and making all subjective judgments related to an investment professionals’ compensation.

 

(22) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, and (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus and equity incentive awards are paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by a percentage of the aggregate assets under management in the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, including the fund, plus, where applicable, a percentage of the assets of the funds they support as research analysts, and by the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Funding for the bonus pool may also include a percentage of any performance fees earned on long/short mutual funds managed by the Team. Senior management of The investment manager has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other employees of the investment manager. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all employees of the investment manager at the same job level.

 

(23) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, a portion of which may be subject to a mandatory deferral program, and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus is paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by the aggregate market competitive bonus targets for the teams of which the portfolio manager is a member and by the short-term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to applicable benchmarks or the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of the investment manager has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other employees of the investment manager. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all employees of the investment manager at the same job level.

 

(24) American Century: The compensation of American Century’s portfolio managers is structured to align the interests of portfolio managers with those of the shareholders whose assets they manage. For the fiscal year ended May 31, 2009, it included the components described below, each of which is determined with reference to a number of factors, such as overall performance, market competition, and internal equity. Compensation is not directly tied to the value of assets held in client portfolios.

Base Salary

Portfolio managers receive base pay in the form of a fixed annual salary.

Bonus

A significant portion of portfolio manager compensation takes the form of an annual incentive bonus tied to performance. Bonus payments are determined by a combination of factors. One factor is fund investment performance. For most American Century mutual funds, investment performance is measured by a combination of one- and three-

 

138


Table of Contents

year pre-tax performance relative to various benchmarks and/or internally-customized peer groups. The performance comparison periods may be adjusted based on a fund’s inception date or a portfolio manager’s tenure on the fund. Custom peer groups are constructed using all the funds in appropriate Lipper or Morningstar categories as a starting point. Funds are then eliminated from the peer group that is both more stable over the long-term (i.e., has less peer turnover) and that more closely represents the fund’s true peers based on internal investment mandates. In 2008, American Century Investments began placing increased emphasis on long-term performance and is phasing in five year performance periods.

Portfolio managers may have responsibility for multiple American Century mutual funds. In such cases, the performance of each is assigned a percentage weight appropriate for the portfolio manager’s relative levels of responsibility.

Portfolio managers also may have responsibility for portfolios that are managed in a fashion similar to that of other American Century mutual funds. This is the case for the Partners Small Cap Equity and Partners Aggressive Growth Funds. If the performance of a similarly managed account is considered for purposes of compensation, it is either measured in the same way as a comparable American Century mutual fund (i.e., relative to the performance of a benchmark and/or peer group) or relative to the performance of such mutual fund. Performance of Partners Small Cap Equity Fund is measured relative to the performance of a comparable American Century mutual fund. Performance of Partners Aggressive Growth Fund is not separately considered in determining portfolio manager compensation.

A second factor in the bonus calculation relates to the performance of all American Century funds managed according to a particular investment style, such as U.S. growth, U.S. value, international, quantitative or fixed income. Performance is measured for each product individually as described above and then combined to create an overall composite for the product group. These composites may measure one-year performance (equal weighted) or a combination of one- and three-year performance (asset weighted) depending on the portfolio manager’s responsibilities and products managed. This feature is designed to encourage effective teamwork among portfolio management teams in achieving long-term investment success for similarly styled portfolios.

A portion of some portfolio managers’ bonuses may be tied to individual performance goals, such as research projects and the development of new products.

Restricted Stock Plans

Portfolio managers are eligible for grants of restricted stock of ACC. These grants are discretionary, and eligibility and availability can vary from year to year. The size of an individual’s grant is determined by individual and product performance as well as other product-specific considerations. Grants can appreciate/depreciate in value based on the performance of the ACC stock during the restriction period (generally three to four years).

Deferred Compensation Plans

Portfolio managers are eligible for grants of deferred compensation. These grants are used in very limited situations, primarily for retention purposes. Grants are fixed and can appreciate/depreciate in value based on the performance of the American Century mutual funds in which the portfolio manager chooses to invest them.

 

(25) Davis: Kenneth Feinberg’s compensation as a Davis Advisors employee consists of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual bonus equal to a percentage of growth in Davis Advisors’ profits, (iii) awards of equity (“Units”) in Davis Advisors including Units, options on Units, and/or phantom Units, and (iv) an incentive plan whereby Davis Advisors purchases shares in selected funds managed by Davis Advisors. At the end of specified periods, generally five years following the date of purchase, some, all, or none of the fund shares will be registered in the employee’s name based on fund performance after expenses on a pre-tax basis versus the S&P 500 Index and versus peer groups as defined by Morningstar or Lipper. Davis Advisors’ portfolio managers are provided benefits packages including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in company 401(k) plan comparable to that received by other company employees.

Christopher Davis’s annual compensation as an employee of Davis Advisors consists of a base salary. Davis Advisors’ portfolio managers are provided benefits packages including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in company 401(k) plan comparable to that received by other company employees.

 

(26) Donald Smith: All employees at Donald Smith & Co., Inc. are compensated on incentive plans. The compensation for portfolio managers, analysts and traders at Donald Smith consists of a base salary, a partnership interest in the firm’s profits, and possibly an additional, discretionary bonus. This discretionary bonus can exceed 100% of the base salary if performance for clients exceeds established benchmarks. The current benchmark utilized is the Russell 2000 Value Index. Additional distribution of firm ownership is a strong motivation for continued employment at Donald Smith & Co., Inc. Administrative personnel are also given a bonus as a function of their contribution and the profitability of the firm.

 

(27)

BHMS: In addition to base salary, all portfolio managers and analysts at BHMS share in a bonus pool that is distributed semi-annually. Analysts and portfolio managers are rated on their value added to the team-oriented investment process. Overall compensation applies with respect to all accounts managed and compensation does not differ with respect to distinct accounts managed by a portfolio manager. Compensation is not tied to a published or private benchmark. It is

 

139


Table of Contents
 

important to understand that contributions to the overall investment process may include not recommending securities in an analyst’s sector if there are no compelling opportunities in the industries covered by that analyst.

The compensation of portfolio managers is not directly tied to fund performance or growth in assets for any fund or other account managed by a portfolio manager and portfolio managers are not compensated for bringing in new business. Of course, growth in assets from the appreciation of existing assets and/or growth in new assets will increase revenues and profit. The consistent, long-term growth in assets at any investment firm is to a great extent, dependent upon the success of the portfolio management team. The compensation of the portfolio management team at the Adviser will increase over time, if and when assets continue to grow through competitive performance.

 

(28) MetWest: MetWest Capital’s compensation system is designed not only to attract and retain experienced, highly qualified investment personnel, but also to closely align employees’ interests with clients’ interests. Compensation for investment professionals consists of a base salary, bonus, and generous benefits. Benefits include a comprehensive insurance benefits program (medical, vision and dental), 401(k) plan with an employer-matched contribution. A material portion of each such professional’s annual compensation is in the form of a bonus tied to results relative to clients’ benchmarks and overall client satisfaction. Bonuses may range from 20% to over 100% of salary.

MetWest Capital’s compensation system is not determined on an account-specific basis. Rather, bonuses are tied to overall firm profitability and composite performance relative to the benchmark. The primary benchmark for the Small Cap Intrinsic Value strategy is the Russell 2000 Value Index. To reinforce long-term focus, performance is measured over MetWest Capital’s investment horizon (typically two to four years). Analysts are encouraged to maintain a long-term focus and are not compensated for the number of their recommendations that are purchased in the portfolio. Rather, their bonuses are tied to overall strategy performance.

Mr. Lisenbee is an owner of MetWest Capital. As such, his compensation consists of a fixed salary and participation in the firm’s profits.

 

(29) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus is paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. Funding for the bonus pool is based upon a percentage of profits generated by the institutional portfolios they manage. Lynn Hopton and Yvonne Stevens may also be paid from a bonus pool based upon the performance of the mutual fund(s) they manage. Funding for this bonus pool is determined by a percentage of the aggregate assets under management in the mutual fund(s) they manage, and by the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of the mutual fund(s) in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of Columbia Management has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the bonus pool related to mutual funds and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Senior management of Columbia Management does not have discretion over the size of the bonus pool related to institutional portfolios. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Columbia Management employees. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Columbia Management employees at the same job level.

 

(30) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, and may include (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus, and in some instances the base salary, are paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by a percentage of the management fees on the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, including the fund. The percentage of management fees that fund the bonus pool is based on the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year and five-year) performance of those accounts in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Funding for the bonus pool may also include a percentage of any performance fees earned on long/short mutual funds managed by the Team. With respect to hedge funds and separately managed accounts that follow a hedge fund mandate, funding for the bonus pool is a percentage of performance fees earned on the hedge funds or accounts managed by the portfolio managers. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Columbia Management employees. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Columbia Management employees at the same job level.

 

140


Table of Contents

 

(31) Columbia WAM: As of December 31, 2008, the portfolio managers received all of their compensation from the Advisor and its parent company, Columbia Management. P. Zachary Egan and Louis J. Mendes each received compensation in the form of salary and incentive compensation. Typically, a high proportion of an analyst’s or portfolio manager’s bonus is paid in cash with a smaller proportion going into two separate incentive plans. The first plan is a notional investment based on the performance of certain Columbia Funds, including the Columbia Acorn Funds. The second plan consists of Bank of America restricted stock and/or options. For 2008, investments in the second plan were made through a deferred cash program. Both plans vest over three years from the date of issuance. The CWAM total incentive compensation pool, including cash and the two incentive plans, is based on formulas, with investment performance of individual portfolio managers and certain analysts, plus firm-wide investment performance, as primary drivers.

Analysts and portfolio managers are positioned in a number of compensation tiers based on cumulative performance of the portfolios they manage. Performance of each Fund for purposes of portfolio manager compensation is measured relative to its primary benchmark. One and three year performance periods primarily drive incentive levels. Excellent performance results in advancement to a higher tier until the highest tier is reached. Higher tiers have higher base compensation levels and wider incentive compensation ranges. While cumulative performance places analysts and managers in tiers, current year performance drives changes in incentive compensation levels. Incentive compensation varies by tier, and can range between a fraction of base pay to several times base pay; the objective being to provide very competitive total compensation for high performing analysts and portfolio managers. If a fund’s performance declines, the compensation incentives available to its analysts and portfolio manager(s) also declines.

 

141


Table of Contents

 

(32) Columbia Management: As of the funds’ most recent fiscal year end, the portfolio managers received all of their compensation in the form of salary, bonus, stock options, restricted stock, and notional investments through an incentive plan, the value of which is measured by reference to the performance of the funds in which the account is invested. A portfolio manager’s bonus is variable and generally is based on (1) an evaluation of the portfolio manager’s investment performance and (2) the results of a peer and/or management review of the portfolio manager, which takes into account skills and attributes such as team participation, investment process, communication and professionalism. In evaluating investment performance, the investment manager generally considers the one, three and five year performance of mutual funds and other accounts managed by the portfolio manager relative to the benchmarks and peer groups noted below, emphasizing the portfolio manager’s three and five year performance. The investment manager also may consider a portfolio manager’s performance in managing client assets in sectors and industries assigned to the portfolio manager as part of his/her investment team responsibilities, where applicable. For portfolio managers who also have group management responsibilities, another factor in their evaluation is an assessment of the group’s overall investment performance.

Performance Benchmarks:

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Alfred F. Alley III

   RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity    Russell 2500 Index    Lipper Mid-Cap Core Funds Classification
   RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value    Russell 200 Value Index    Lipper Small Cap Value Funds Classification
   RiverSource S&P 500 Index    S&P 500 Index    Lipper S&P 500 Index Objective Funds Classification
   RiverSource Small Company Index    S&P Small Cap 600 Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification

Anwiti Bahuguna, Colin Moore, Kent Peterson and Marie M. Schofield

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive, Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive and Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    S&P 500 Index    Lipper Large Cap Core Funds Classification
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative    Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate 1-3 Years Index and Blended: 80% Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate 1-3 Years Index, 20% Barclays Capital U.S. Corporate High-Yield Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative    S&P 500 Index and Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Conservative Funds Classification
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate    S&P 500 Index and Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed-Asset Target Allocation Growth Funds Classification
   Columbia Retirement Plus Funds    S&P 500 Index, Russell 1000 Index, Russell 1000 Value Index, Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index, MSCI The World Index Net, and MSCI EAFE Index Net    N/A
   Columbia Strategic Allocation    S&P 500 Index and Barclays Capital Aggregate Bond Index    Lipper Mixed Asset Target Allocation Moderate Funds Classification

Brian M. Condon

   Columbia Large Core Quantitative    S&P 500 Index    Lipper S&P 500 Index Objective Funds Classification
   Columbia Large Growth Quantitative    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Columbia Disciplined Large Value Quantitative    Russell 1000 Value Index    Lipper Large Cap Value Funds Classification
   RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity    Russell 2500 Index    Lipper Mid Cap Core Funds Classification
   RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value    Russell 2000 Value Index    Lipper Small Cap Value Funds Classification

Fred Copper

   RiverSource Disciplined International Equity    MSCI EAFE Value Index    Lipper International Multi-Cap Value Funds Classification

Wayne M. Collette, Lawrence W. Lin, George Myers and Brian D. Neigut

   Seligman Capital    Russell MidCap TR and Russell MidCap Growth TR    Lipper Mid-Cap Growth Funds Classification
   Columbia Frontier    Russell 2000 TR and Russell 2000 Growth TR    Lipper Small Cap Growth Funds Classification

 

142


Table of Contents

 

Portfolio Manager

  

Fund(s)

  

Benchmark(s)

  

Peer Group

Peter Deininger and John Wilson

   Seligman Growth    Russell 1000 Growth Index    Lipper Large-Cap Growth Funds Classification

Cheryl D’Hollander

   RiverSource S&P 500 Index    S&P 500 Index    Lipper S&P 500 Index Objective Funds Classification
   RiverSource Small Company Index    S&P Small Cap 600 Index    Lipper Small-Cap Core Funds Classification

Michael E. Hoover

   RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining    S&P North American Natural Resources Sector Index    Lipper Natural Resources Funds Classification

Arthur J. Hurley

   RiverSource Real Estate    FTSE NAREIT Equity REITs Index    Lipper Real Estate Funds Classification

Laura A. Ostrander

   RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation    Barclays Capital Government/Credit Bond Index and Blended Benchmark    Lipper Multi-Sector Income Funds Classification

 

(1) A custom composite, established by the Advisor, consisting of a 35% weighting of the Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index, a 35% weighting of the JPMorgan Global High Yield Index, a 15% weighting of the Citigroup Non-U.S. World Government Bond Index — Unhedged and a 15% weighting of the JPMorgan EMBI Global Diversified Index.

The size of the overall bonus pool each year depends on, among other factors, the levels of compensation generally in the investment management industry (based on market compensation data) and the investment manager’s profitability for the year, which is largely determined by assets under management.

 

(33) AllianceBernstein: AllianceBernstein’s compensation program for investment professionals is designed to be competitive and effective in order to attract and retain the highest caliber employees. The compensation program for investment professionals is designed to reflect their ability to generate long-term investment success for our clients. Investment professionals do not receive any direct compensation based upon the investment returns of any individual client account, nor is compensation tied directly to the level or change in the level of assets under management. Investment professionals’ annual compensation is comprised of the following:

 

  (i) Fixed base salary: This is generally the smallest portion of compensation. The base salary is a relatively low, fixed salary within a similar range for all investment professionals. The base salary does not change significantly from year-to-year, and hence, is not particularly sensitive to performance.

 

  (ii) Discretionary incentive compensation in the form of an annual cash bonus: AllianceBernstein’s overall profitability determines the total amount of incentive compensation available to investment professionals. This portion of compensation is determined subjectively based on qualitative and quantitative factors. In evaluating this component of an investment professional’s compensation, AllianceBernstein considers the contribution to his/her team or discipline as it relates to that team’s overall contribution to the long-term investment success, business results and strategy of AllianceBernstein. Quantitative factors considered include, among other things, relative investment performance (e.g., by comparison to competitor or peer group funds or similar styles of investments, and appropriate, broad-based or specific market indices), and consistency of performance. There are no specific formulas used to determine this part of an investment professional’s compensation and the compensation is not tied to any pre-determined or specified level of performance. AllianceBernstein also considers qualitative factors such as the complexity and risk of investment strategies involved in the style or type of assets managed by the investment professional; success of marketing/business development efforts and client servicing; seniority/length of service with the firm; management and supervisory responsibilities; and fulfillment of AllianceBernstein’s leadership criteria.

 

  (iii) Discretionary incentive compensation in the form of awards under AllianceBernstein’s Partners Compensation Plan (“deferred awards”): AllianceBernstein’s overall profitability determines the total amount of deferred awards available to investment professionals. The deferred awards are allocated among investment professionals based on criteria similar to those used to determine the annual cash bonus. Deferred awards, which are in the form of AllianceBernstein’s publicly traded securities, vest over a four-year period and are generally forfeited if the employee resigns or AllianceBernstein terminates his/her employment.

 

  (iv) Contributions under AllianceBernstein’s Profit Sharing/401(k) Plan: The contributions are based on AllianceBernstein’s overall profitability. The amount and allocation of the contributions are determined at the sole discretion of AllianceBernstein.

 

(34) Mondrian: Mondrian has the following programs in place to retain key investment staff:

 

  1. Competitive Salary — All investment professionals are remunerated with a competitive base salary.

 

  2. Profit Sharing Bonus Pool — All Mondrian staff, including portfolio managers and senior officers, qualify for participation in an annual profit sharing pool determined by the company’s profitability (approximately 30% of profits).

 

  3. Equity Ownership — Mondrian is ultimately controlled by a partnership of senior management and Hellman & Friedman LLC, an independent private equity firm. Mondrian is currently 67% owned by its senior employees, including the majority of investment professionals, senior client service officers, and senior operations personnel.

 

143


Table of Contents
 

The private equity funds sponsored by Hellman & Friedman LLC are passive, non-controlling minority investors in Mondrian and do not have day-to-day involvement in the management of Mondrian.

Incentives (Bonus and Equity Programs) focus on the key areas of research quality, long-term and short-term stock performance, teamwork, client service and marketing. As an individual’s ability to influence these factors depends on that individual’s position and seniority within the firm, so the allocation of participation in these programs will reflect this.

At Mondrian, the investment management of particular portfolios is not “star manager” based but uses a team system. This means that Mondrian’s investment professionals are primarily assessed on their contribution to the team’s effort and results, though with an important element of their assessment being focused on the quality of their individual research contribution.

Compensation Committee

In determining the amount of bonuses and equity awarded, Mondrian’s Board of Directors consults with the company’s Compensation Committee, who will make recommendations based on a number of factors including investment research, organization management, team work, client servicing and marketing.

Defined Contribution Pension Plan

All portfolio managers are members of the Mondrian defined contribution pension plan where Mondrian pays a regular monthly contribution and the member may pay additional voluntary contributions if they wish. The Plan is governed by Trustees who have responsibility for the trust fund and payments of benefits to members. In addition, the Plan provides death benefits for death in service and a spouse’s or dependant’s pension may also be payable.

Mondrian believes that this compensation structure, coupled with the opportunities that exist within a successful and growing business, are adequate to attract and retain high caliber employees.

 

(35) Tradewinds: Tradewinds offers a highly competitive compensation structure with the purpose of attracting and retaining the most talented investment professionals. These professionals are rewarded through a combination of cash and long-term incentive compensation as determined by the firm’s executive committee. Total cash compensation (TCC) consists of both a base salary and an annual bonus that can be a multiple of the base salary. The firm annually benchmarks TCC to prevailing industry norms with the objective of achieving competitive levels for all contributing professionals.

Available bonus pool compensation is primarily a function of the firm’s overall annual profitability. Individual bonuses are based primarily on the following:

 

   

Overall performance of client portfolios;

 

   

Objective review of stock recommendations and the quality of primary research;

 

   

Subjective review of the professional’s contributions to portfolio strategy, teamwork, collaboration and work ethic.

To further strengthen our incentive compensation package and to create an even stronger alignment to the long-term success of the firm, Tradewinds has made available to most investment professionals equity participation opportunities, the values of which are determined by the increase in profitability of Tradewinds over time.

Finally, some of our investment professionals have received additional remuneration as consideration for signing employment agreements. These agreements range from retention agreements to long-term employment contracts with significant non-solicitation and, in some cases, non-compete clauses.

 

(36) Threadneedle: To align the interests of our investment staff with those of our clients the remuneration plan for senior individuals comprises basic salary, an annual profit share (linked to individual performance and the profitability of the company) and a Long Term Incentive Plan known as the Equity Incentive Plan (“EIP”) linked to measures of Threadneedle’s corporate success. Threadneedle believes this encourages longevity of service.

The split between each component varies between investment professionals and will be dependent on performance and the type of funds they manage.

The split of the profit share focuses on three key areas of success:

 

   

Performance of own funds and research recommendations,

 

   

Performance of all portfolios in the individual’s team,

 

   

Broader contribution to the wider thinking of the investment team, e.g. idea generation, interaction with colleagues and commitment for example to assisting the sales effort.

Consideration of the individual’s general contribution is designed to encourage fund managers to think beyond personal portfolio performance and considers contributions made in:

 

   

Inter-team discussions, including asset allocation, global sector themes and weekly investment meetings,

 

   

Intra-team discussion, stock research and investment insights,

 

   

Marketing support, including written material and presentations.

It is important to appreciate that in order to maximize an individual’s rating and hence their profit share, they need to score well in all areas. It is not sufficient to produce good personal fund performance without contributing effectively to

 

144


Table of Contents

the team and wider investment department. This structure is closely aligned with the Threadneedle’s investment principles of sharing ideas and effective communication.

 

(37) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus, and (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus and equity incentive awards are paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. The bonus pool is determined by a percentage of the aggregate assets under management in the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, including the fund, plus, where applicable, a percentage of the assets of the funds they support as research analysts, and by the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year) performance of those accounts in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Funding for the bonus pool may also include a percentage of any performance fees earned on long/short mutual funds managed by the Team. Senior management of Columbia Management has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Columbia Management employees. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Columbia Management employees at the same job level.

 

(38) Columbia Management: Portfolio manager compensation is typically comprised of (i) a base salary, (ii) an annual cash bonus and (iii) an equity incentive award in the form of stock options and/or restricted stock. The annual cash bonus and equity incentive awards are paid from a team bonus pool that is based on the performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio management team, which might include mutual funds, wrap accounts, institutional portfolios and hedge funds. Funding for the bonus pool is determined by the short term (typically one-year) and long-term (typically three-year and five-year) performance of the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, including the fund, in relation to the relevant peer group universe. Senior management of Columbia Management has the discretion to increase or decrease the size of the part of the bonus pool and to determine the exact amount of each portfolio manager’s bonus paid from this portion of the bonus pool based on his/her performance as an employee. Portfolio managers are provided with a benefits package, including life insurance, health insurance, and participation in a company 401(k) plan, comparable to that received by other Columbia Management employees. Certain investment personnel are also eligible to defer a portion of their compensation. An individual making this type of election can allocate the deferral to the returns associated with one or more products they manage or support or to certain other products managed by their investment team. Depending upon their job level, portfolio managers may also be eligible for other benefits or perquisites that are available to all Columbia Management employees at the same job level.

 

(39) LaSalle: Compensation for Investment Team Members consists of a base salary and incentive compensation that is based primarily upon performance of the particular Investment Team and that of the subadviser with which an Investment Team Member is employed, and meeting financial objectives for the Investment Team. The annual performance of clients’ portfolios and/or the performance of stock recommendations against a sector index (generally the NAREIT-Equity REITs Index or the Wilshire REIT Index in respect of the Investment Team Members of LaSalle Securities US, or the EPRA Euro Zone Index and EPRA Europe Index in respect of the Investment Team Member of LaSalle Securities B.V.) is one factor included in professional employee evaluations, but compensation is not directly linked to these performance criteria.

In addition, equity ownership in Jones Lang LaSalle, the subadvisers’ publicly-traded parent, is available to and expected of senior professionals. The major components of Jones Lang LaSalle’s comprehensive equity ownership program are: (1) Stock Ownership Program — credits employees with a portion of their incentive compensation in the form of restricted stock; (2) Employee Stock Purchase Plan — program through which employees may elect to purchase shares of Jones Land LaSalle through a payroll deduction plan (available to employees of LaSalle Securities US) and; (3) Stock Award Incentive Plan rewards key employees of the firm with stock awards, in the form of restricted stock units, based on the strength of their individual contributions.

 

145


Table of Contents

 

ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICES

Each fund listed in the table below has an Administrative Services Agreement with Ameriprise Financial. Under this agreement, the fund pays Ameriprise Financial for providing administration and accounting services. The fee is calculated as follows:

Table 20. Administrative Services Agreement Fee Schedule

 

    Asset Levels and Breakpoints in Applicable Fees  

Fund

  $0 – 500,000,000     $500,000,001  –
1,000,000,000
    $1,000,000,001  –
3,000,000,000
    $3,000,000,001  –
$12,000,000,000
    12,000,000,001 +  

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

    0.080     0.075     0.070     0.060     0.050

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

         

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

         

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

         

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

         

Columbia European Equity

         

Columbia Frontier

         

Columbia Global Bond

         

Columbia Global Equity

         

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

         

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

         

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

         

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

         

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

         

Columbia Strategic Allocation

         

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

         

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

         

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

         

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

         

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

         

RiverSource Small Company Index

         

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

         

Threadneedle International Opportunity

         

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

    0.070     0.065     0.060     0.050     0.040

Columbia Diversified Bond

         

Columbia Floating Rate

         

Columbia High Yield Bond

         

Columbia Income Opportunities

         

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

         

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

         

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

         

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

         

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

         

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

         

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

         

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

         

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

         

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

         

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

         

Seligman California Municipal Quality

         

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

         

Seligman National Municipal

         

Seligman New York Municipal

         

 

146


Table of Contents

 

    Asset Levels and Breakpoints in Applicable Fees  

Fund

  $0 – 500,000,000     $500,000,001  –
1,000,000,000
    $1,000,000,001  –
3,000,000,000
    $3,000,000,001  –
$12,000,000,000
    12,000,000,001 +  

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

    0.060     0.055     0.050     0.040     0.030

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

         

Columbia Equity Value

         

Columbia Government Money Market

         

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

         

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

         

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

         

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

         

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

         

Columbia Money Market

         

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

         

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

         

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

         

RiverSource Balanced

         

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

         

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

         

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

         

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

         

RiverSource Real Estate

         

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

         

Seligman Capital

         

Seligman Growth

         

Seligman TargETFund 2015

         

Seligman TargETFund 2025

         

Seligman TargETFund 2035

         

Seligman TargETFund 2045

         

Seligman TargETFund Core

         

Columbia Income Builder Fund

    0.020     0.020     0.020     0.020     0.020

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

         

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

         

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

         

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

         

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

         

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

         

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

         

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

         

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

         

 

147


Table of Contents

 

The fee is calculated for each calendar day on the basis of net assets as of the close of the preceding day. Fees paid in each of the last three fiscal periods are shown in the table below. The table also shows the daily rate applied to each fund’s net assets as of the last day of the most recent fiscal period. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 21. Administrative Fees

 

     Administrative services fees paid in:     Daily rate
applied  to
fund assets
 
      

Fund

   2010      2009     2008    

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

         

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   $ 45,313       $ 56,956      $ 38,041 (a)      0.020

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     78,128         108,149        82,229 (a)      0.020   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     38,950         54,275        45,848 (a)      0.020   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     89,504         96,644        110,897        0.020   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     45,451         36,929        26,665        0.020   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     201,685         193,553        183,783        0.020   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     186,977         205,250        223,400        0.020   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     75,988         72,830        62,617        0.020   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     75,724         84,413        101,924        0.020   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     69,721         101,230        158,059        0.060   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     293,026         446,427        738,676        0.080   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

         

Columbia Equity Value

     391,620         448,794        680,124        0.058   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     83,021         64,531        77,686        0.060   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

         

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     31,739         31,071        13,416 (b)      0.080   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     199,325         4,214 (c)      N/A        0.059   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     1,647         2,441        3,623        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     4,050         4,449        5,483        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     4,355         4,871        7,572        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     4,903         5,145        7,280        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     4,981         5,001        7,160        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     3,476         3,258        4,249        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     2,435         2,051        4,915        0.020   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     2,262         1,726        1,670        0.020   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

         

Columbia High Yield Bond

     1,077,547         722,190        1,069,014        0.065   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     300,718         277,260        565,329        0.080   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     181,856         252,478        285,601        0.070   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     340,508         374,303        594,407        0.060   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     470,119         521,265        541,748        0.069   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

         

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

     681,093         642,082        1,033,158        0.057   

RiverSource Real Estate

     103,295         91,566        132,646        0.060   

 

148


Table of Contents

 

     Administrative services fees paid in:     Daily rate
applied  to
fund assets
 
      

Fund

   2010      2009     2008    

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

         

Columbia Floating Rate

   $ 282,996       $ 253,669      $ 398,924        0.070

Columbia Income Opportunities

     499,304         219,083        202,872        0.068   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     451,332         515,776        399,972        0.069   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     1,911,088         1,094,618        1,701,542        0.050   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     317,896         123,147        115,529        0.069   

Columbia Money Market

     1,551,462         2,132,989        2,507,729        0.053   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     83,767         77,180        38,114        0.060   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     40,614         34,017        30,592        0.080   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

         

Columbia Diversified Bond

     2,608,739         2,122,615        2,012,548        0.057   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     235,979         212,293        215,249        0.070   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     110,167         113,317        122,235        0.070   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     38,266         37,590        41,455        0.070   
     2009      2008     2007        

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

  

      

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     203,583         101,276        11,405 (d)      0.059   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     69,490         662 (e)      N/A        0.060   

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

     1,985,768         3,272,256        3,449,519        0.048   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     946,227         1,335,281        1,196,773        0.054   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     962,590         1,505,894        1,340,234        0.076   

RiverSource Balanced

     331,811         519,542        623,784        0.059   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     137,849         115,139        21,493 (d)      0.070   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield*

     7,436         N/A        N/A        0.070   

Seligman California Municipal Quality*

     8,837         N/A        N/A        0.070   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal*

     14,896         N/A        N/A        0.070   

Seligman National Municipal*

     42,999         N/A        N/A        0.069   

Seligman New York Municipal*

     17,197         N/A        N/A        0.070   

Seligman TargETFund 2015*

     4,585         N/A        N/A        0.060   

Seligman TargETFund 2025*

     5,686         N/A        N/A        0.060   

Seligman TargETFund 2035*

     1,661         N/A        N/A        0.060   

Seligman TargETFund 2045*

     835         N/A        N/A        0.060   

Seligman TargETFund Core*

     10,074         N/A        N/A        0.060   

 

149


Table of Contents

 

     Administrative services fees paid in:      Daily rate
applied  to
fund assets
 
       

Fund

   2009     2008     2007     

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

  

      

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   $ 417,444      $ 373,454      $ 79,761         0.080

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan

     7,807 (f)      N/A        N/A         0.080   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     146,703        131,334        78,549         0.080   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     280,656        498,019        503,279         0.079   

Columbia European Equity

     50,304        96,107        105,886         0.080   

Columbia Frontier*

     10,073        N/A        N/A         0.030   

Columbia Global Bond

     401,109        572,976        388,646         0.080   

Columbia Global Equity

     340,869        549,601        611,621         0.080   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     4,908        1,256 (g)      N/A         0.080   

Columbia International Multi-Advisor Value

     651,133        1,395,090        1,759,221         0.078   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology*

     102,757        N/A        N/A         0.040   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     282,974        549,173        209,295         0.080   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     282,773        511,522        490,174         0.080   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     38,884        79,183        92,062         0.080   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

     16,780        1,528 (g)      N/A         0.080   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     281,413        460,205        540,718         0.080   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

         

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     339,961        471,791        652,889         0.059   

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     453,062        463,150        525,515         0.069   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     61,016        52,367        57,618         0.070   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     1,428,680        1,603,416        1,823,812         0.063   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

         

Columbia Government Money Market*

     41,094        N/A        N/A         0.060   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value*

     76,758        N/A        N/A         0.060   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value*

     96,841        N/A        N/A         0.080   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information*

     868,517        N/A        N/A         0.050   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate*

     5,942        N/A        N/A         0.080   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate*

     7,968        N/A        N/A         0.060   

Seligman Capital*

     68,772        N/A        N/A         0.060   

Seligman Growth*

     299,785        N/A        N/A         0.055   

 

* Prior to June 15, 2009 for Seligman California Municipal High-Yield, Seligman California Municipal Quality, Seligman Minnesota Municipal, Seligman New York Municipal, Seligman TargETFund 2015, Seligman TargETFund 2025, Seligman TargETFund 2035, Seligman TargETFund 2045, Seligman TargETFund Core, Columbia Seligman Global Technology, Columbia Government Money Market, RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate and RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate and prior to June 29, 2009 for Seligman Capital, Columbia Frontier, Columbia Seligman Communications and Information, Seligman Growth, Columbia Select Large-Cap Value and Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value, and for Seligman National, prior to Aug. 31, 2009, the fund did not pay a separate administrative services fee. Fees for administration services were included in the fund’s management fees as charged by the fund’s pervious investment manager.
(a) The fund changed its fiscal year end effective Jan. 31, 2008 from May 31 to Jan. 31. For 2008, the information shown is for the period from June 1, 2007 through Jan. 31, 2008. For years prior to 2008, the fiscal period ended on May 31.
(b) For the period from Oct. 18, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2008.
(c) For the period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(d) For the period from May 17, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2007.
(e) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(f) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when the Fund became available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(g) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2008.

 

150


Table of Contents

 

TRANSFER AGENCY SERVICES

The funds have a Transfer Agency Agreement with Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (the “transfer agent”) (formerly RiverSource Service Corporation) located at One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111. This agreement governs the transfer agent’s responsibility for administering and/or performing transfer agent functions, for acting as service agent in connection with dividend and distribution functions and for performing shareholder account administration agent functions in connection with the issuance, exchange and redemption or repurchase of the fund’s shares.

For Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R, Class R3, Class R4, Class R5, Class W, Class Y and Class Z, the transfer agent will earn an open account fee determined by multiplying the number of open accounts by the annual rate of $12.08. The annual per account fee is accrued daily and payable monthly. The fund will allocate the fee daily across their share classes based on the relative percentage of net assets of each class of shares.

In addition, for Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R, Class W and Class Z, the fund reimburses the transfer agent for the fees and expenses the transfer agent pays to financial intermediaries that maintain omnibus accounts with the fund subject to an annual limitation of 0.20% of the average aggregate value of the fund’s shares maintained in each such omnibus account (other than omnibus accounts for which American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc. is the broker of record or accounts where the beneficial shareholder is a customer of Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc., which are reimbursed in an amount equal to $16.00 annually, calculated monthly based on the total number of positions in such account at the end of such month). For Class R3, Class R4 and Class R5, the fees paid to the transfer agent for expenses paid to financial intermediaries to maintain omnibus accounts are subject to an annual limitation of 0.05% of the net assets attributable to such shares. Class I does not pay transfer agency fees.

The fund also pays certain reimbursable out-of-pocket expenses to the transfer agent. The transfer agent also may retain as additional compensation for its services revenues for fees for wire, telephone and redemption orders, IRA trustee agent fees and account transcripts due the transfer agent from fund shareholders and credits (net of bank charges) earned with respect to balances in accounts the transfer agent maintains in connection with its services to the funds. The fees paid to the transfer agent may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval.

PLAN ADMINISTRATION SERVICES

The funds that offer Class R3 and Class R4 shares have a Plan Administration Services Agreement with the transfer agent. Under the agreement the fund pays for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and Health Savings Accounts (HSAs).

The fee for services is equal on an annual basis to 0.25% of the average daily net assets of the fund attributable to each of Class R3 and R4.

The fees paid to the transfer agent may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval.

DISTRIBUTION SERVICES

Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (the “distributor”) (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.), an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of Columbia Management, One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, serves as the funds’ principal underwriter and distributor. Prior to June 1, 2009, for RiverSource and Threadneedle funds, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. also served as principal underwriter and distributor to the funds. Prior to Oct. 1, 2007, for RiverSource and Threadneedle funds, Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc. also served as principal underwriter and distributor to the funds. Prior to Nov. 7, 2008, for Seligman funds, Seligman Advisors, Inc. also served as principal underwriter and distributor to the funds. The fund’s shares are offered on a continuous basis. Under a Distribution Agreement, sales charges deducted for distributing fund shares are paid to the distributor daily. The following table shows the sales charges paid to the distributor and the amount retained by the distributor after paying commissions and other expenses for each of the last three fiscal periods. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 22. Sales Charges Paid to Distributor

 

     Sales charges paid to Distributor     Amount retained after paying
commissions and other expenses
 

Fund

   2010      2009      2008     2010     2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

  

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   $ 245,462       $ 466,216       $ 688,587 (a)    $ (86,426   $ (21,562   $ (56,086 )(a) 

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     293,969         654,937         1,279,681 (a)      (109,209     77,641        34,001 (a) 

 

151


Table of Contents
     Sales charges paid to Distributor     Amount retained after paying
commissions and other expenses
 

Fund

   2010      2009     2008     2010     2009     2008  

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

   $ 189,070       $ 296,977      $ 831,981 (a)    $ (27,745   $ (533   $ 176,661 (a) 

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     1,656,276         2,081,242        2,848,037        417,384        552,795        799,417   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     524,245         528,590        384,348        8,450        16,829        4,989   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     2,911,626         3,277,766        3,944,827        507,020        661,689        702,939   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     3,171,640         4,181,445        5,635,597        795,856        1,125,393        1,613,677   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     885,194         982,012        1,088,559        111,387        153,386        140,630   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     1,059,706         1,561,130        2,257,735        202,573        319,114        471,536   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     N/A         N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A        N/A   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     265,422         365,094        563,878        265,422        317,088        117,897   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

             

Columbia Equity Value

     245,798         374,068        496,313        28,520        65,246        16,594   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     224,264         159,379        192,503        6,986        55,468        50,572   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

             

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     44,207         57,137        149,480 (b)      2,401        5,429        46,196 (b) 

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

     1,817,351         221,190 (c)      N/A        337,598        (7,085 )(c)      N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     6,098         7,536        32,694        2,480        1,465        11,266   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     12,014         17,354        70,298        5,364        5,173        50,360   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     20,614         26,015        41,850        8,068        12,539        21,519   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     15,117         21,208        49,187        6,222        7,872        25,003   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     14,540         19,999        51,530        5,797        9,336        28,063   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     11,125         14,670        31,469        5,669        6,101        19,162   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     18,304         17,700        39,332        8,927        8,815        21,208   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     15,018         16,697        23,890        6,063        6,510        12,087   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

             

Columbia High Yield Bond

     1,321,507         974,983        882,107        297,716        108,896        41,174   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     305,205         287,969        607,350        56,453        38,780        117,005   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     109,683         101,207        136,891        (17,796     (70,344     (116,397

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     340,583         494,967        766,263        14,174        43,220        58,252   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     392,239         530,165        660,354        35,955        107,433        (152,827

 

152


Table of Contents

 

     Sales charges paid to Distributor     Amount retained after paying
commissions and other expenses
 

Fund

   2010      2009     2008     2010     2009     2008  

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

             

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   $ 1,058,723       $ 798,182      $ 1,648,530      $ 175,949      $ 39,934      $ 206,622   

RiverSource Real Estate

     80,410         98,301        211,915        15,331        18,158        63,306   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

             

Columbia Floating Rate

     240,774         189,836        380,143        (11,075     11,806        (174,369

Columbia Income Opportunities

     1,196,954         951,690        135,655        271,045        251,745        (11,090

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     236,120         332,292        407,706        15,969        101,013        51,044   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     1,610,548         261,402        412,821        377,765        67,822        85,890   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     1,033,053         145,544        92,255        119,494        17,573        9,475   

Columbia Money Market

     106,803         367,743        339,219        106,058        367,712        339,111   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     25,721         24,097        26,228        7,017        7,132        7,923   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     5,507         8,386        6,647        1,133        2,011        1,943   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

             

Columbia Diversified Bond

     1,584,251         1,922,949        1,992,222        77,260        (92,219     176,513   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     551,051         406,782        463,447        2,712        84,001        37,217   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     96,842         92,347        91,928        13,668        9,806        5,945   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     31,250         20,992        29,401        6,331        8,033        8,217   
     2009      2008     2007     2009     2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

             

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   $ 3,383,179       $ 6,331,545      $ 9,553,810      $ 496,151      $ 1,204,186      $ 1,407,616   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     69,425         87,685        20,834 (d)      15,099        30,621        5,197 (d) 

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     2,270         0 (e)      N/A        566        0 (e)      N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     954,172         2,444,490        3,538,910        207,568        898,395        862,120   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     2,055,294         5,371,458        8,570,846        347,495        1,321,113        1,738,063   

RiverSource Balanced

     189,413         287,586        474,702        39,038        36,359        32,524   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     600,969         400,285        267,319 (d)      2,484        28,302        26,129 (d) 

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

     37,316         98,702        18,611        36,272        13,104        3,125   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

     60,005         37,798        15,149        56,335        5,413        2,159   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

     66,716         49,497        35,607        55,756        6,427        4,740   

Seligman National Municipal

     222,346         57,892        18,992        199,904        7,651        3,601   

Seligman New York Municipal

     166,632         48,724        31,659        157,302        7,550        6,334   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     22,260         77,218        242,913        22,260        9,521        25,977   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     26,925         79,939        188,122        26,925        9,918        19,976   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     3,094         13,483        13,573        2,975        1,677        1,493   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     7,658         27,815        7,910        7,508        3,493        791   

Seligman TargETFund Core

     24,251         126,638        297,932        24,251        15,617        30,512   

 

153


Table of Contents

 

     Sales charges paid to Distributor      Amount retained after paying
commissions and other expenses
 

Fund

   2009      2008     2007      2009      2008     2007  

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

               

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

     118,256         288,047        10,519         40,664         52,383        3,448   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan(f)

     N/A         N/A        N/A         N/A         N/A        N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     70,770         41,906        25,743         28,245         10,486        1,421   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     558,505         780,872        886,062         140,308         (4,109,358     (7,004,024

Columbia European Equity

     68,398         124,828        226,464         19,191         35,391        90,745   

Columbia Frontier

     1,357         10,431        25,638         735         1,351        3,856   

Columbia Global Bond

     218,412         391,577        314,002         32,697         118,930        215,442   

Columbia Global Equity

     361,007         800,774        896,578         60,748         114,011        99,098   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     8,674         1,795 (g)      N/A         3,445         307 (g)      N/A   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

     580,503         1,584,444        4,085,674         68,413         235,164        641,699   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

     221,563         265,528        309,290         184,936         233,685        274,719   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     61,779         168,692        130,761         8,596         36,899        14,894   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     213,399         560,302        885,940         43,200         118,125        226,007   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     53,930         88,479        164,026         26,245         20,053        19,649   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

     38,564         18,558 (g)      N/A         7,576         4,340 (g)      N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     168,431         319,850        501,090         37,276         49,744        56,669   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

               

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     477,836         319,831        313,115         100,280         64,831        (19,725

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     453,947         360,393        608,683         131,709         59,123        115,052   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     75,578         59,348        62,985         3,223         (792     (10,183

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     1,164,712         1,042,555        1,182,244         192,881         151,444        181,059   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

               

Columbia Government Money Market

     22,845         N/A        N/A         22,830         N/A        N/A   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     83,550         112,370        67,382         72,301         14,405        8,773   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     73,571         31,742        65,218         39,883         4,542        8,361   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     3,487,463         1,478,105        2,850,171         3,197,170         187,649        320,100   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     14,337         4,931        439,574         13,946         638        50,672   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     15,219         19,987        95,027         14,907         2,839        10,193   

Seligman Capital

     30,899         34,577        66,383         27,966         6,030        11,356   

Seligman Growth

     336,636         43,178        48,116         115,283         11,948        10,926   

 

(a) The fund changed its fiscal year end effective Jan. 31, 2008 from May 31 to Jan. 31. For 2008, the information shown is for the period from June 1, 2007 through Jan. 31, 2008. For years prior to 2008, the fiscal period ended on May 31.
(b) For the period from Oct. 18, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2008.
(c) For the period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(d) For the period from May 17, 2007 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2007.
(e) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Sept. 30, 2008.
(f) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when the Fund became available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(g) For the period from Aug. 1, 2008 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2008.

Part of the sales charge may be paid to selling dealers who have agreements with the distributor. The distributor will retain the balance of the sales charge. At times the entire sales charge may be paid to selling dealers.

 

154


Table of Contents

 

PLAN AND AGREEMENT OF DISTRIBUTION

To help defray the cost of distribution and/or servicing not covered by the sales charges received under the Distribution Agreement, the Legacy RiverSource funds approved a Plan of Distribution (the “Plan”) and entered into an agreement under the Plan pursuant to Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act. The Plan is a reimbursement plan whereby the fund pays the distributor a fee up to actual expenses incurred.

The table below shows the maximum annual distribution and/or service fees (as an annual percent of average daily net assets) and the combined amount of such fees (as an annual percent of average daily net assets) applicable to each share class of a Legacy RiverSource fund:

 

Share Class

   Distribution Fee   Service Fee   Combined Total

Class A

   up to 0.25%   up to 0.25%   0.25%(a)

Class B

   0.75%   0.25%   1.00%(b)

Class C

   0.75%   0.25%   1.00%(a)

Class I

   None   None   None

Class R (formerly Class R2)

   up to 0.50%   up to 0.25%   0.50%(a),(c)

Class R3

   0.25%   0.25%(d)   0.50%(d)

Class R4

   None   0.25%(d)   0.25%(d)

Class R5

   None   None   None

Class W

   up to 0.25%   up to 0.25%   0.25%(a)

Class Z

   None   None   None

 

(a) Fee amounts noted apply to all funds other than Columbia Money Market Fund, which, for each of Class A and Class W shares, pays distribution and service fees of 0.10%, and for Class C shares pays distribution fees of 0.75%. The distributor has voluntarily agreed, effective April 15, 2010, to waive the 12b-1 fees it receives from Class A, Class C, Class R (formerly Class R2) and Class W shares of Columbia Money Market Fund and from Class A, Class C and Class R (formerly Class R2) shares of Columbia Government Money Market Fund. Compensation paid to broker-dealers and other financial intermediaries may be suspended to the extent of the distributor’s waiver of the 12b-1 fees on these specific share classes of these funds.
(b) Fee amounts noted apply to all funds other than Columbia Money Market Fund, which pays distribution fees of up to 0.75% and service fees of up to 0.10% for a combined total of 0.85%. Effective after the close of business on Sept. 3, 2010, Class B shares will be closed to new and existing investors.
(c) The Legacy RiverSource funds have a distribution and shareholder service plan for Class R shares, which, prior to the close of business on Sept. 3, 2010, were known as Class R2 shares. For Class R shares, the maximum fee under the plan reimbursed for distribution expenses is equal on an annual basis to 0.50% of the average daily net assets of the fund attributable to Class R shares. Of that amount, up to 0.25% may be reimbursed for shareholder service expenses.
(d) The shareholder service fees for Class R3 and Class R4 shares are not paid pursuant to a 12b-1 plan. Under a Plan Administration Services Agreement, the funds’ Class R3 and Class R4 shares pay for plan administration services, including services such as implementation and conversion services, account set-up and maintenance, reconciliation and account recordkeeping, education services and administration to various plan types, including 529 plans, retirement plans and health savings accounts.

The distribution and/or shareholder service fees for Class A, Class B, Class C, Class R (formerly Class R2), Class R3 and Class W shares, as applicable, are subject to the requirements of Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act, and are to reimburse the distributor for certain expenses it incurs in connection with distributing the fund’s shares and directly or indirectly providing services to fund shareholders. These payments or expenses include providing distribution and/or shareholder service fees to selling and/or servicing agents that sell shares of the fund or provide services to fund shareholders. The distributor may retain these fees otherwise payable to selling and/or servicing agents if the amounts due are below an amount determined by the distributor in its discretion.

For the Legacy RiverSource funds, for Class A, Class B and Class W shares, the distributor begins to pay these fees immediately after purchase. For Class C shares, the distributor pays these fees in advance for the first 12 months. Selling and/or servicing agents also receive distribution fees up to 0.75% of the average daily net assets of Class C shares sold and held through them, which the distributor begins to pay 12 months after purchase. For Class B shares, and, for the first 12 months following the sale of Class C shares, the distributor retains the distribution fee of up to 0.75% in order to finance the payment of sales commissions to selling and/or servicing agents, and to pay for other distribution related expenses. Selling and/or servicing agents may compensate their financial advisors with the shareholder service and distribution fees paid to them by the Distributor.

 

155


Table of Contents

 

If you maintain shares of the fund directly with the fund, without working directly with a financial advisor or selling and/or servicing agent, distribution and service fees are retained by the distributor as payment or reimbursement for incurring certain distribution and shareholder service related expenses.

Over time, these distribution and/or shareholder service fees will reduce the return on your investment and may cost you more than paying other types of sales charges. The fund will pay these fees to the distributor and/or to eligible selling and/or servicing agents for as long as the distribution and/or shareholder servicing plans continue in effect. The fund may reduce or discontinue payments at any time. Your selling and/or servicing agent may also charge you other additional fees for providing services to your account, which may be different from those described here.

For its most recent fiscal period, each fund paid 12b-1 fees as shown in the following table. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 23. 12b-1 Fees

 

Fund

   Class A      Class B      Class C      Class D*      Class R*      Class R3      Class W  

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

                    

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   $ 471,671       $ 273,352       $ 105,503         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     843,392         386,458         146,186         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     420,462         181,976         83,149         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

     906,136         651,430         196,648         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

     427,544         415,794         145,696         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

     2,010,066         1,572,878         469,838         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

     1,896,292         1,394,436         362,267         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

     744,235         615,354         206,862         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

     769,440         529,603         177,552         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

     N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 54,437         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Small Company Index

     781,451         482,501         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

                    

Columbia Equity Value

     1,484,672         513,603         42,567         N/A       $ 52       $ 369       $ 8   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

     303,284         137,925         31,060         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

                    

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

     80,959         14,686         19,355         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure(a)

     573,841         125,316         127,106         N/A         93         39         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

     7,863         N/A         N/A         N/A         18         10         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

     12,794         N/A         N/A         N/A         18         10         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

     11,607         N/A         N/A         N/A         146         8         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

     6,809         N/A         N/A         N/A         97         8         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

     10,004         N/A         N/A         N/A         45         13         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

     4,104         N/A         N/A         N/A         17         8         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

     3,831         N/A         N/A         N/A         50         70         N/A   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

     3,364         N/A         N/A         N/A         18         8         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

                    

Columbia High Yield Bond

     3,126,170         1,016,761         599,062         N/A         19,571         5,898         263,891   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

     629,566         635,056         71,205         N/A         2,666         433         N/A   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

     195,150         198,412         44,904         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

     846,835         604,556         88,558         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

     1,289,353         810,418         242,435         N/A         11,521         N/A         12   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

                    

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

     2,335,959         777,706         197,105         N/A         228         11         10   

RiverSource Real Estate

     128,018         64,833         11,302         N/A         N/A         N/A         6   

 

156


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Class A      Class B      Class C      Class D*      Class R*      Class R3      Class W  

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

                    

Columbia Floating Rate

   $ 661,379       $ 129,749       $ 172,291         N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 11   

Columbia Income Opportunities

     1,165,157         362,360         508,953         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

     676,148         221,294         156,599         N/A       $ 5,707         N/A         401,982   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

     6,447,567         1,947,821         209,143         N/A         9,201       $ 14         1,372,152   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

     710,400         120,305         341,535         N/A         N/A         N/A         12   

Columbia Money Market

     2,064,367         421,815         29,890         N/A         5         N/A         14,212   

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

     25,573         9,144         2,729         N/A         N/A         N/A         265,113   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

     19,337         2,362         1,006         N/A         17         12         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

                    

Columbia Diversified Bond

     7,117,570         1,741,108         582,197         N/A         2,116         26         1,070,556   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

     779,724         88,473         163,760         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

     379,034         25,963         31,712         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

     129,187         19,927         9,978         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

                    

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

     7,673,291         4,133,298         654,310         N/A         32,750         224,770         7   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

     285,822         31,420         14,405         N/A         31         16         148,342   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

     2,658         717         132         N/A         33         16         203,257   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

     2,975,723         1,048,865         359,404         N/A         56,692         82,312         7   

Columbia Strategic Allocation

     2,727,681         1,272,157         456,933         N/A         16         8         N/A   

RiverSource Balanced

     1,240,431         190,901         34,422         N/A         54         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

     421,534         206,718         76,158         N/A         23         11         N/A   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

     42,842         N/A         54,350         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Seligman California Municipal Quality

     54,798         N/A         34,584         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

     99,128         N/A         9,092         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Seligman National Municipal

     461,232         N/A         105,746         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Seligman New York Municipal

     99,753         N/A         67,646         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     29,037         N/A         116,119         N/A         7,361         N/A         N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     34,200         N/A         114,588         N/A         11,757         N/A         N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     10,620         N/A         17,945         N/A         6,060         N/A         N/A   

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     6,401         N/A         6,705         N/A         3,486         N/A         N/A   

Seligman TargETFund Core

     45,600         N/A         289,930         N/A         41,727         N/A         N/A   

 

157


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Class A      Class B      Class C      Class D*      Class R*      Class R3      Class W  

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

                    

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   $ 416,349       $ 35,353       $ 98,315         N/A         N/A         N/A       $ 530,074   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan(b)

     N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

     35,486         15,974         3,265         N/A         N/A         N/A         254,174   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

     715,248         302,533         99,973         N/A       $ 13,518         N/A         N/A   

Columbia European Equity

     134,391         81,471         9,558         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Frontier

     56,264         11,282         86,834         N/A         453       $ 3         N/A   

Columbia Global Bond

     593,225         367,588         44,351         N/A         N/A         N/A         147,100   

Columbia Global Equity

     884,744         362,565         57,394         N/A         192         8         8   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

     5,199         2,820         1,035         N/A         36         18         N/A   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

     1,476,812         892,831         106,186         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

     469,642         85,618         559,118         N/A         15,300         3         N/A   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

     115,524         76,758         9,922         N/A         15         7         530,215   

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

     414,628         250,377         42,614         N/A         110         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

     57,422         42,653         4,096         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

     38,589         17,080         2,551         N/A         36         18         N/A   

Threadneedle International Opportunity

     576,787         226,132         30,118         N/A         1,240         8         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

                    

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

     1,580,370         189,971         72,103         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

     1,123,363         500,167         46,013         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt

     197,660         44,588         36,432         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

     5,482,675         487,040         137,058         N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

                    

Columbia Government Money Market(c)

     54,819         51,551         133,682         N/A         6,985         N/A         N/A   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

     5,402,710         1,008,895         5,611,229         N/A         133,982         11         N/A   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

     324,397         67,910         372,709         N/A         34,736         6         N/A   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

     274,250         132,950         382,137         N/A         43,885         5         N/A   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

     15,681         N/A         27,290         N/A         248         6         N/A   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

     15,884         20,254         84,243         N/A         15,651         6         N/A   

Seligman Capital

     350,797         65,892         404,801         N/A         42,283         6         N/A   

Seligman Growth

     1,283,827         316,419         239,516         N/A         4,129         5         N/A   

 

* Effective Sept. 7, 2010, Class D was renamed as Class A and Class R2 was renamed as Class R.
(a) For the period from Feb. 19, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to April 30, 2009.
(b) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2009.
(c) Effective March 27, 2009, Class C2 shares converted to Class A shares. The amount attributable to Class C2 prior to the conversion is $4,804.

 

158


Table of Contents

 

For funds with Class B and Class C shares:

The following table provides the amount of distribution expenses, as a dollar amount and as a percentage of net assets, incurred by the distributor and not yet reimbursed (“unreimbursed expense”) for Class B and Class C shares. These amounts are based on the most recent information available as of July 31, 2010 and may be recovered from future payments under the distribution plan or CDSC. To the extent the unreimbursed expense has been fully recovered, the distribution fee is reduced.

Table 24. Unreimbursed Distribution Expenses

 

     Class B      Percentage of
Class B
net assets
    Class C      Percentage of
Class C
net assets
 

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund

   $ 83,000         5.34   $ 17,000         0.82

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

     58,000         4.20     19,000         0.36

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund

     372,000         2.73     84,000         0.87

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund

     7,421,000         4.42     783,000         1.29

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund

     15,146,000         4.63     753,000         1.14

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund

     3,160,000         4.35     230,000         1.01

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund

     107,000         2.85     52,000         3.38

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund

     1,096,000         2.58     1,496,000         4.30

Columbia Equity Value Fund

     1,495,000         3.47     59,000         1.32

Columbia European Equity Fund

     179,000         3.35     22,000         1.73

Columbia Floating Rate Fund

     718,000         5.45     145,000         0.68

Columbia Frontier Fund

     15,000         0.14     1,294,000         12.29

Columbia Global Bond Fund

     1,130,000         4.36     83,000         1.43

Columbia Global Equity Fund

     1,321,000         4.49     1,518,000         15.96

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund

     37,000         10.10     1,000         0.67

Columbia Government Money Market Fund

     92,000         2.13     2,847,000         18.16

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund

     3,225,000         3.51     8,946,000         12.49

Columbia Income Builder Fund

     1,718,000         7.31     105,000         0.74

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

     2,301,000         7.02     97,000         0.61

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

     1,182,000         7.53     62,000         0.70

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund

     1,550,000         4.33     212,000         0.35

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

     1,055,000         5.20     179,000         1.04

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund

     10,407,000         5.12     1,342,000         6.10

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund

     157,000         4.85     11,000         0.67

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

     4,000         1.94     1,000         1.10

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund

     541,000         3.44     387,000         0.79

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund

     1,527,000         N/A        88,000         0.73

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund

     4,111,000         3.43     279,000         0.64

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt fund

     187,000         2.05     168,000         0.87

Columbia Money Market Fund

     5,787,000         12.85     26,000         0.33

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund

     3,708,000         5.77     175,000         1.96

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund

     1,809,000         3.07     109,000         1.45

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund

     3,030,000         4.32     170,000         0.62

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund

     2,093,000         5.36     169,000         0.78

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund

     6,581,000         4.49     1,177,000         2.30

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund

     3,079,000         5.08     269,000         0.90

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund

     7,877,000         4.63     1,561,000         2.17

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund

     2,563,000         4.68     1,377,000         5.29

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund

     317,000         1.55     130,000         0.45

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund

     101,000         1.90     3,010,000         6.96

 

159


Table of Contents

 

     Class B      Percentage of
Class B
net assets
    Class C      Percentage of
Class C
net assets
 

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund

   $ 722,000         2.20   $ 2,781,000         6.14

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund

     865,000         1.01     20,528,000         3.10

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund

     505,000         2.25     4,631,000         6.30

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund

     6,013,000         6.61     409,000         1.11

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund

     845,000         4.81     52,000         0.90

RiverSource Balanced Fund

     704,000         4.45     1,477,000         16.33

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

     75,000         2.88     30,000         0.89

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

     321,000         5.81     14,000         1.52

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

     50,000         6.37     5,000         2.44

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

     16,000         9.43     2,000         1.66

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

     109,000         3.43     54,000         0.82

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

     N/A         N/A        788,000         35.06

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

     27,000         1.16     317,000         14.10

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

     54,000         2.85     11,000         0.10

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

     2,349,000         4.69     128,000         12.88

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

     944,000         4.53     2,023,000         24.87

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

     213,000         4.09     2,000         0.03

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

     364,000         2.61     42,000         0.19

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

     384,000         5.38     15,000         0.32

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

     3,429,000         5.28     1,491,000         93.39

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

     1,330,000         3.12     N/A         N/A   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

     1,143,000         4.15     119,000         0.63

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

     835,000         2.38     182,000         1.06

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield Fund

     N/A         N/A        242,000         4.19

Seligman California Municipal Quality Fund

     N/A         N/A        203,000         6.00

Seligman Capital Fund

     68,000         1.72     5,273,000         12.95

Seligman Growth Fund

     3,750,000         4.29     2,110,000         8.12

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Fund

     N/A         N/A        93,000         5.84

Seligman National Municipal Fund

     N/A         N/A        2,282,000         6.73

Seligman New York Municipal Fund

     N/A         N/A        265,000         3.12

Seligman TargETFund 2015

     N/A         N/A        982,000         10.39

Seligman TargETFund 2025

     N/A         N/A        1,063,000         8.43

Seligman TargETFund 2035

     N/A         N/A        328,000         12.46

Seligman TargETFund 2045

     N/A         N/A        192,000         17.84

Seligman TargETFund Core

     N/A         N/A        1,787,000         7.24

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

     87,000         3.93     6,000         0.95

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

     716,000         3.95     62,000         0.85

PAYMENTS TO FINANCIAL INTERMEDIARIES

The distributor and its affiliates make or support additional cash payments out of their own resources (including profits earned from providing services to the funds) to financial intermediaries, including payment to affiliated broker-dealers, in connection with agreements between the distributor and financial intermediaries pursuant to which these financial intermediaries sell fund shares and provide services to their clients who are shareholders of the funds. These payments do not change the price paid by investors and fund shareholders for the purchase or ownership of shares of the funds, and these payments are not reflected in the fees and expenses of the funds, as they are not paid by the funds. These payments are in addition to fees paid by the funds to the distributor under 12b-1 plans, which fees may be used to compensate financial intermediaries for the distribution of fund shares and the servicing of fund shareholders, or paid by the funds to the transfer agent under the transfer agent agreement or plan administration agreement, which fees may be used to support networking or

 

160


Table of Contents

servicing fees to compensate financial intermediaries for supporting shareholder account maintenance, sub-accounting, plan recordkeeping or other services provided directly by the financial intermediary to shareholders or plans and plan participants, including retirement plans, 529 plans, Health Savings Account plans, or other plans, where participants beneficially own shares of the funds.

These payments are typically made pursuant to an agreement between the distributor and the financial intermediary, and are typically made in support of marketing and sales support efforts or program and shareholder servicing, as further described below. These payments are usually calculated based on a percentage of fund assets owned through the financial intermediary and/or as a percentage of fund sales attributable to the financial intermediary. Certain financial intermediaries require flat fees instead of or in addition to these asset-based fees as compensation for including or maintaining funds on their platforms, and, in certain situations, may require the reimbursement of ticket or operational charges — fees that a financial intermediary charges its representatives for effecting transactions in the funds. The amount of payment varies by financial intermediary, and often is significant. In addition, the amount of payments may differ based upon the type of fund sold or maintained; for instance, the amount of payments for an equity fund may differ from payments for a money-market or fixed income fund. Asset-based payments generally will be made in a range of up to 0.25% of assets or 0.25% of sales or some combination thereof. Exceptions to these general ranges will be considered on a case-by-case basis. Flat fees or annual minimum fees required by a financial intermediary in addition to such asset-based fees, are considered on a case-by-case basis.

Marketing and Sales Support

Payments may be paid in support of retail, institutional, plan or other fee-based advisory program distribution efforts. These payments are typically made by the distributor in its efforts to advertise to and/or educate the financial intermediary’s personnel, including its registered representatives, about the fund. As a result of these payments, the distributor may obtain a higher profile and greater visibility for the fund within the financial intermediary’s organization, including placement of the fund on the financial intermediary’s preferred or recommended list. The distributor may also obtain greater access to sales meetings, sales representatives, and management representatives of the financial intermediary, including potentially having increased opportunity for fund representatives to participate in and/or present at conferences or seminars, sales or training programs for invited registered representatives and their clients and other events sponsored by the financial intermediary.

Program and Shareholder Servicing

Payments may be made in support of recordkeeping, reporting, transaction processing, and other plan administration services provided by a financial intermediary to or through retirement plans, 529 plans, Health Savings Account plans, or other plans or fee-based advisory programs but may also be made in support of certain retail advisory programs, including wrap programs. A financial intermediary may perform program services itself or may arrange with a third party to perform program services. These payments may also include services rendered in connection with fund selection and monitoring, employee enrollment and education, plan balance rollover or separation, or other similar services.

Below is a list of firms that the distributor and its affiliates make payments to for the above described services.

 

   

ACS HR Solutions

 

   

ADP Broker-Dealer, Inc.

 

   

American Century Investment Management, Inc. and American Century Investment Services, Inc.

 

   

Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc./American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.

 

   

Associated Securities Corp.

 

   

Benefit Plans Administrative Services, Inc. and Community Bank System, Inc.

 

   

Boston Financial Data Services, Inc.

 

   

Charles Schwab Trust Company

 

   

Charles Schwab and Company, Inc.

 

   

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

 

   

Columbia Management Advisors, LLC and Columbia Management Distributors, Inc.

 

   

Digital Retirement Solutions, Inc.

 

   

Expertplan, Inc.

 

   

Fidelity Brokerage Services/National Financial Services

 

   

Fidelity Investments Institutional Operations Company/Fidelity Investments Institutional Service Company

 

   

FTJ Fund Choice, LLC

 

   

GWFS Equities, Inc.

 

   

Hartford Life Insurance Company

 

   

Hartford Securities Distribution Company, Inc.

 

   

ICMA-RC Services LLC

 

   

ING Institutional Plan Services, LLC

 

   

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Company

 

   

J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, N.A.

 

   

J.P. Morgan Retirement Plan Services, LLC

 

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company

 

   

John Hancock Life Insurance Company New York

 

   

Lincoln Retirement Services Company LLC

 

   

LPL Financial Corporation

 

   

Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company (Mass Mutual/MML)

 

161


Table of Contents

 

   

Mercer HR Services, LLC

 

   

Merrill Lynch Life Insurance Company

 

   

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith, Inc.

 

   

Mid Atlantic Capital Corporation

 

   

Minnesota Life Insurance Company

 

   

ML Life Insurance Company of New York

 

   

Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc.

 

   

MSCS Financial Services, LLC

 

   

Mutual Service Corporation

 

   

Nationwide Financial Services, Inc.

 

   

Newport Retirement Services, Inc.

 

   

NYLife Distributors LLC

 

   

Oppenheimer & Co. Inc.

 

   

Principal Life Insurance Company

 

   

Prudential Insurance Company of America/Prudential Investments Retirement Services

 

   

Prudential Investment Management Services LLC/Prudential Investments LLC

 

   

Raymond James & Associates, Inc. and Raymond James Financial Services, Inc.

 

   

RBC Capital Markets Corporation

 

   

Reliance Trust Company

 

   

The Retirement Plan Company, LLC

 

   

Securities America, Inc.

 

   

Standard Retirement Services, Inc.

 

   

TD Ameritrade Trust Company

 

   

The Princeton Retirement Group, Inc. and GPC Securities, Inc.

 

   

UBS Financial Services, Inc.

 

   

UVest Financial Services Group, Inc.

 

   

The Vanguard Group, Inc.

 

   

Vertical Management Systems, Inc.

 

   

Wachovia Bank NA

 

   

Waterstone Financial Group, Inc.

 

   

Wells Fargo Advisors Financial Network, LLC

 

   

Wells Fargo Bank N.A.

 

   

Wilmington Trust Company

 

   

Wilmington Trust Retirement and Institutional Services Company

Other Payments

The distributor and its affiliates may separately pay financial intermediaries in order to participate in and/or present at conferences or seminars, sales or training programs for invited registered representatives and other financial intermediary employees, client and investor events and other financial intermediary-sponsored events, and for travel expenses, including lodging incurred by registered representatives and other employees in connection with prospecting, asset retention and due diligence trips. The amount of these payments varies depending upon the nature of the event. The distributor and its affiliates make payments for such events as they deem appropriate, subject to internal guidelines and applicable law.

From time to time, to the extent permitted by SEC and NASD rules and by other applicable laws and regulations, the distributor and its affiliates may make other reimbursements or payment to financial intermediaries or their registered representatives, including non-cash compensation, in the form of gifts of nominal value, occasional meals, tickets, or other entertainment, support for due diligence trips, training and educational meetings or conference sponsorships, support for recognition programs, and other forms of non-cash compensation permissible under regulations to which these financial intermediaries and their representatives are subject. To the extent these are made as payments instead of reimbursement, they may provide profit to the financial intermediary to the extent the cost of such services was less than the actual expense of the service.

The financial intermediary through which you are purchasing or own shares of funds has been authorized directly or indirectly by the distributor to sell funds and/or to provide services to you as a shareholder of funds. Investors and current shareholders may wish to take such payment arrangements into account when considering and evaluating any recommendations they receive relating to fund shares.

If you have questions regarding the specific details regarding the payments your financial intermediary may receive from the distributor or its affiliates related to your purchase or ownership of funds, please contact your financial intermediary.

CUSTODIAN SERVICES

The funds’ securities and cash are held pursuant to a custodian agreement with JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (JPMorgan), 1 Chase Manhattan Plaza, 19th Floor, New York, NY 10005. The custodian is permitted to deposit some or all of their securities in central depository systems as allowed by federal law. For its services, each fund pays its custodian a maintenance charge and a charge per transaction in addition to reimbursing the custodian’s out-of-pocket expenses.

As part of this arrangement, securities purchased outside the United States are maintained in the custody of various foreign branches of JPMorgan or in other financial institutions as permitted by law and by the fund’s custodian agreement.

 

162


Table of Contents

 

BOARD SERVICES CORPORATION

The funds have an agreement with Board Services Corporation (Board Services) located at 901 Marquette Avenue South, Suite 2810, Minneapolis, MN 55402. This agreement sets forth the terms of Board Services’ responsibility to serve as an agent of the funds for purposes of administering the payment of compensation to each Independent Director, to provide office space for use by the funds and their boards, and to provide any other services to the boards or the independent members, as may be reasonably requested.

Organizational Information

Each fund is an open-end management investment company. The funds’ headquarters are at 901 S. Marquette Ave., Suite 2810, Minneapolis, MN 55402-3268.

SHARES

The shares of a fund represent an interest in that fund’s net assets only (and profits or losses), and, in the event of liquidation, each share of a fund would have the same rights to dividends and assets as every other share of that fund.

VOTING RIGHTS

As a shareholder in a fund, you have voting rights over the fund’s management and fundamental policies. You are entitled to vote based on your total dollar interest in the fund. Each class, if applicable, has exclusive voting rights with respect to matters for which separate class voting is appropriate under applicable law. Shares of the RiverSource and Threadneedle funds have cumulative voting rights with respect to the election of Board members. This means that you have as many votes as the dollar amount you own, including the fractional amount, multiplied by the number of members to be elected, all of which may, in the shareholder’s discretion, be voted for a single director. The Seligman funds do not provide for cumulative voting rights.

DIVIDEND RIGHTS

Dividends paid by a fund, if any, with respect to each applicable class of shares will be calculated in the same manner, at the same time, on the same day, and will be in the same amount, except for differences resulting from differences in fee structures.

SHAREHOLDER LIABILITY

For funds organized as Massachusetts business trusts, under Massachusetts law, shareholders of a Massachusetts business trust may, under certain circumstances, be held personally liable as partners for its obligation. However, the Declaration of Trust that establishes a trust, a copy of which, together with all amendments thereto (the “Declaration of Trust”), is on file with the office of the Secretary of the Commonwealth of Massachusetts for each applicable fund, contains an express disclaimer of shareholder liability for acts or obligations of the Trust, or of any fund in the Trust. The Declaration of Trust provides that, if any shareholder (or former shareholder) of a fund in the Trust is charged or held to be personally liable for any obligation or liability of the Trust, or of any fund in the Trust, solely by reason of being or having been a shareholder and not because of such shareholder’s acts or omissions or for some other reason, the Trust (upon request of the shareholder) shall assume the defense against such charge and satisfy any judgment thereon, and the shareholder or former shareholder (or the heirs, executors, administrators or other legal representatives thereof, or in the case of a corporation or other entity, its corporate or other general successor) shall be entitled (but solely out of the assets of the fund of which such shareholder or former shareholder is or was the holder of shares) to be held harmless from and indemnified against all loss and expense arising from such liability.

The Declaration of Trust also provides that the Trust may maintain appropriate insurance (for example, fidelity bond and errors and omissions insurance) for the protection of the Trust, its shareholders, Trustees, officers, employees and agents covering possible tort and other liabilities. Thus, the risk of a shareholder incurring financial loss on account of shareholder liability is limited to circumstances in which both inadequate insurance existed and the Trust itself was unable to meet its obligations.

The Declaration of Trust further provides that obligations of the Trust are not binding upon the Trustees individually, but only upon the assets and property of the Trust, and that the Trustees will not be liable for any action or failure to act, errors of judgment, or mistakes of fact or law, but nothing in the Declaration of Trust or other agreement with a Trustee protects a

 

163


Table of Contents

Trustee against any liability to which he or she would otherwise be subject by reason of his or her willful bad faith, gross negligence, or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of his or her office. By becoming a shareholder of the fund, each shareholder shall be expressly held to have assented to and agreed to be bound by the provisions of the Declaration of Trust.

Table 25. Fund History Table

 

Fund*

 

Date of
Organization

  Date Began
Operations
 

Form of
Organization

 

State of
Organization

  Fiscal
Year
End
 

Diversified**

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc.

  7/9/84   12/10/84   Corporation   MD   10/31   Yes

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.(19)

  10/8/82   6/23/83   Corporation   MD   12/31   Yes

RiverSource Bond Series, Inc.(2)

  4/29/81, 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   7/31  

Columbia Floating Rate Fund

    2/16/06         Yes

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund

    6/19/03         Yes

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund

    3/4/04         No

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund(19)

    6/19/03         Yes

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Trust

  4/7/86     Business Trust   MA   8/31(10)  

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

    8/18/86         No

RiverSource Dimensions Series, Inc.

  2/20/68, 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   7/31  

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

    2/16/06         Yes

RiverSource Diversified Income Series, Inc.(2)

  6/27/74,  4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   8/31  

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund(3)

    10/3/74         Yes

RiverSource Equity Series, Inc.

  3/18/57, 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   11/30  

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund(4),(19)

    6/4/57         Yes

RiverSource Global Series, Inc.

  10/28/88     Corporation   MN   10/31  

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund

    6/15/06         Yes

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund

    2/16/06         No

Columbia Global Bond Fund

    3/20/89         No

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund(4),(5),(11),(19)

    11/13/96         Yes

Columbia Global Equity Fund(5),(6),(11)

    5/29/90         Yes

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund

    8/1/08         Yes

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

    8/1/08         Yes

RiverSource Government Income Series, Inc.

  3/12/85     Corporation   MN   5/31  

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund

    2/14/02         Yes

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund(3)

    8/19/85         Yes

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc.(17)

  6/29/76   1/31/77   Corporation   MD   12/31   Yes

RiverSource High Yield Income Series, Inc.

  8/17/83     Corporation   MN   5/31  

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund(3)

    12/8/83         Yes

RiverSource Income Series, Inc.

  2/10/45;  4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   1/31(7)  

Columbia Income Builder Fund(19)

    2/16/06         Yes

Columbia Income Builder Fund II(19)

    2/16/06         Yes

Columbia Income Builder Fund III(19)

    2/16/06         Yes

RiverSource International Managers Series, Inc.(2)

  5/9/01     Corporation   MN   10/31  

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value
Fund
(11),(19)

    9/28/01         Yes

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth
Fund
(11)

    9/28/01         Yes

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap
Fund
(11)

    10/3/02         Yes

 

164


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

 

Date of
Organization

  Date Began
Operations
 

Form of
Organization

 

State of
Organization

  Fiscal
Year
End
 

Diversified**

RiverSource International Series, Inc.(2)

  7/18/84     Corporation   MN   10/31  

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund(19)

    7/15/09         Yes

Columbia European Equity Fund(5),(11)

    6/26/00         Yes

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund(4),(5),(11)

    11/15/84         Yes

RiverSource Investment Series, Inc.

  1/18/40; 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   9/30  

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund

    10/15/90         Yes

Columbia Large Quantitative Growth Fund(19)

    5/17/07         Yes

Columbia Large Quantitative Value Fund(19)

    8/1/08         Yes

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund(19)

    2/14/02         Yes

RiverSource Balanced Fund(4)

    4/16/40         Yes

RiverSource Large Cap Series, Inc.(2)

  5/21/70, 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   7/31  

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund(4),(19)

    4/24/03         Yes

RiverSource Managers Series, Inc.(2)

  3/20/01     Corporation   MN   5/31  

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value
Fund
(11),(19)

    6/18/01         Yes

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund(11)

    6/18/01         Yes

RiverSource Market Advantage Series, Inc.

  8/25/89     Corporation   MN   1/31  

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund

    3/4/04         Yes

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund

    3/4/04         Yes

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund

    3/4/04         Yes

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund

    3/4/04         Yes

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund

    3/4/04         Yes

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund

    3/4/04         Yes

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

    10/25/99         Yes

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

    8/19/96         Yes

RiverSource Money Market Series, Inc.

  8/22/75; 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   7/31  

Columbia Money Market Fund(19)

    10/6/75         Yes

RiverSource Sector Series, Inc.

  3/25/88     Corporation   MN   6/30  

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund(8)

    8/1/88         Yes

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

    3/4/04         No

RiverSource Selected Series, Inc.

  10/5/84     Corporation   MN   3/31  

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund(9)

    4/22/85         No

RiverSource Series Trust(14)

  1/27/06     Business Trust   MA   4/30  

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund

    10/18/07         Yes

Columbia Marsico Flexible Capital Fund

    9/28/10         No

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund

    2/19/09         No

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund

    5/18/06         Yes

RiverSource Short Term Investments Series, Inc.(15)

  4/23/68, 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   7/31  

Columbia Short-Term Cash Fund

    9/26/06         Yes

RiverSource Special Tax-Exempt Series Trust

  4/7/86     Business Trust   MA   8/31(10)  

 

165


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

 

Date of
Organization

  Date Began
Operations
 

Form of
Organization

 

State of
Organization

  Fiscal
Year
End
 

Diversified**

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund

    8/18/86         No

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

    8/18/86         No

RiverSource Strategic Allocation Series, Inc.(2)

  10/9/84     Corporation   MN   9/30  

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund(4)

    1/23/85         Yes

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

    5/17/07         Yes

RiverSource Strategy Series, Inc.

  1/24/84     Corporation   MN   3/31  

Columbia Equity Value Fund

    5/14/84         Yes

RiverSource Tax-Exempt Income Series, Inc.(2)

  12/21/78;  4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   11/30  

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund(4)

    5/7/79         Yes

RiverSource Tax-Exempt Series, Inc.

  9/30/76, 4/8/86(1)     Corporation   NV/MN   11/30  

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund(19)

    11/24/76         Yes

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

    11/13/96         Yes

RiverSource Variable Series Trust(12)

  9/11/07     Business Trust   MA   12/31  

Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolios – Aggressive

    5/1/08         Yes

Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolios – Conservative

    5/1/08         Yes

Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolios – Moderate

    5/1/08         Yes

Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolios – Moderately Aggressive

    5/1/08         Yes

Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolios – Moderately Conservative

    5/1/08         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Balanced Fund(4)

    4/30/86         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Cash Management Fund

    10/31/81         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Core Equity Fund

    9/10/04         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Diversified Bond Fund(3)

    10/13/81         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Diversified Equity Income Fund

    9/15/99         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Dynamic Equity Fund(5),(16)

    10/13/81         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Global Bond Fund

    5/1/96         No

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Global Inflation Protected Securities Fund(13)

    9/13/04         No

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – High Yield Bond Fund(3)

    5/1/96         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Income Opportunities Fund

    6/1/04         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Mid Cap Growth Fund(4)

    5/1/01         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Mid Cap Value Fund

    5/2/05         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – S&P 500 Index Fund

    5/1/00         Yes

RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Short Duration U.S. Government Fund(3)

    9/15/99         Yes

Seligman Variable Portfolio – Growth Fund(16)

    9/15/99         Yes

Seligman Variable Portfolio – Larger-Cap Value Fund(16)

    02/4/04         Yes

Seligman Variable Portfolio – Smaller-Cap Value Fund(16)

    9/15/99         Yes

Threadneedle Variable Portfolio – Emerging Markets Fund(4),(5),(11)

    5/1/00         Yes

Threadneedle Variable Portfolio – International Opportunity Fund(4),(5),(11)

    1/13/92         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Aggressive Portfolio

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — AllianceBernstein International Value Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — American Century Diversified Bond Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — American Century Growth Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Columbia Wanger International Equities Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Columbia Wanger U.S. Equities Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Conservative Portfolio

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Davis New York Venture
Fund
(11), (18)

    5/1/06         Yes

 

166


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

 

Date of

Organization

  Date Began
Operations
 

Form of

Organization

 

State of

Organization

  Fiscal
Year
End
 

Diversified**

Variable Portfolio — Eaton Vance Floating-Rate Income Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Goldman Sachs Mid Cap Value
Fund
(11), (18)

    2/4/04         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Invesco International Growth Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — J.P. Morgan Core Bond Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Jennison Mid Cap Growth Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Marsico Growth Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — MFS Value Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Moderate Portfolio

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Moderately Aggressive Portfolio

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Moderately Conservative Portfolio

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Mondrian International Small Cap Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Morgan Stanley Global Real Estate Fund

    4/14/10         No

Variable Portfolio — NFJ Dividend Value Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Partners Small Cap Growth Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Partners Small Cap Value Fund(11), (18)

    8/14/01         Yes

Variable Portfolio — PIMCO Mortgage-Backed Securities Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Pyramis International Equity Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — UBS Large Cap Growth Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Variable Portfolio — Wells Fargo Short Duration Government Fund

    4/14/10         Yes

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

  10/21/68   10/9/69   Corporation   MD   12/31   Yes

Seligman Global Fund Series, Inc.

  11/22/91     Corporation   MD   10/31  

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund(19)

    5/23/94         Yes

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

  1/26/37   4/1/37   Corporation   MD   12/31   Yes

Seligman LaSalle Real Estate Fund Series, Inc.

  5/30/03     Corporation   MD   12/31  

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund(17)

    12/29/06         No

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate
Fund
(17)

    7/16/03         Yes

Seligman Municipal Fund Series, Inc.

  8/8/83     Corporation   MD   9/30  

Seligman National Municipal Class

    12/31/83         Yes

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

    12/30/83         No

Seligman New York Municipal Class

    1/3/84         No

Seligman Municipal Series Trust

  7/25/84     Business Trust   MA   9/30  

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield Series

    11/20/84         No

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

    11/20/84         No

Seligman Portfolios, Inc.

  7/1/87     Corporation   MD   12/31  

Seligman Capital Portfolio

    6/21/88         Yes

Seligman Common Stock Portfolio

    6/21/88         Yes

Seligman Communications and Information Portfolio

    10/11/94         Yes

Seligman Global Technology Portfolio

    5/1/96         Yes

Seligman International Growth Portfolio

    5/3/93         Yes

Seligman Investment Grade Fixed Income Portfolio

    6/21/88         Yes

Seligman Large-Cap Value Portfolio

    5/1/98         Yes

Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Portfolio

    5/1/98         Yes

Seligman TargetHorizon ETF Portfolios, Inc.

  7/6/05     Corporation   MD   9/30  

Seligman TargETFund 2015

    10/3/05         Yes

Seligman TargETFund 2025

    10/3/05         Yes

Seligman TargETFund 2035

    10/2/06         Yes

Seligman TargETFund 2045

    10/2/06         Yes

 

167


Table of Contents

 

Fund*

 

Date of
Organization

  Date Began
Operations
 

Form of
Organization

 

State of
Organization

  Fiscal
Year
End
 

Diversified**

Seligman TargETFund Core

    10/3/05         Yes

Seligman Value Fund Series, Inc.

  1/27/97     Corporation   MD   12/31  

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund(19)

    4/25/97         Yes

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund(19)

    4/25/97         Yes

 

* Effective Oct. 1, 2005 American Express Funds changed its name to RiverSource funds and the names Threadneedle and Partners were removed from fund names. Effective Sept. 27, 2010, several of the funds were renamed from RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle to Columbia.
** If a Non-diversified fund is managed as if it were a diversified fund for a period of three years, its status under the 1940 Act will convert automatically from Non-diversified to diversified. A diversified fund may convert to Non-diversified status only with shareholder approval.
(1) Date merged into a Minnesota corporation incorporated on April 8, 1986.
(2) Effective April 21, 2006, AXP Discovery Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Bond Series, Inc.; AXP Fixed Income Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Diversified Income Series, Inc.; AXP Growth Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Large Cap Series, Inc.; AXP High Yield Tax-Exempt Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Tax-Exempt Income Series, Inc.; AXP Managed Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Strategic Allocation Series, Inc.; AXP Partners International Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource International Managers Series, Inc.; AXP Partners Series, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Managers Series, Inc.; and for all other corporations and business trusts, AXP was replaced with RiverSource in the registrant name.
(3) Effective June 27, 2003, Bond Fund changed its name to Diversified Bond Fund, Federal Income Fund changed its name to Short Duration U.S. Government Fund and Extra Income Fund changed its name to High Yield Bond Fund, Variable Portfolio – Bond Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Diversified Bond Fund, Variable Portfolio – Extra Income Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – High Yield Bond Fund and Variable Portfolio – Federal Income Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Short Duration U.S. Government Fund.
(4) Effective Oct. 1, 2005, Equity Select Fund changed its name to Mid Cap Growth Fund, High Yield Tax-Exempt Fund changed its name to Tax-Exempt High Income Fund, Managed Allocation Fund changed its name to Strategic Allocation Fund, Mutual changed its name to Balanced Fund, Quantitative Large Cap Equity Fund changed its name to Disciplined Equity Fund, and Threadneedle International Fund changed its name to International Opportunity Fund. Variable Portfolio – Equity Select Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Mid Cap Growth Fund, Variable Portfolio – Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Emerging Markets Fund, Variable Portfolio – Threadneedle International Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – International Opportunity Fund, and Variable Portfolio – Managed Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Balanced Fund.
(5) Effective July 9, 2004, Emerging Markets Fund changed its name to Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund, European Equity Fund changed its name to Threadneedle European Equity Fund, Global Equity Fund changed its name to Threadneedle Global Equity Fund, and International Fund changed its name to Threadneedle International Fund, Variable Portfolio – Capital Resource Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Large Cap Equity Fund, Variable Portfolio – Emerging Markets Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund and Variable Portfolio – International Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Threadneedle International Fund.
(6) Effective Oct. 20, 2003, Global Growth Fund changed its name to Global Equity Fund.
(7) Effective Jan. 31, 2008, the fiscal year end was changed from May 31 to Jan. 31.
(8) Effective Feb. 18, 2004, Utilities Fund changed its name to Dividend Opportunity Fund.
(9) Effective Nov. 1, 2006, Precious Metals Fund changed its name to Precious Metals and Mining Fund.
(10) Effective April 13, 2006, the fiscal year end was changed from June 30 to Aug. 31.
(11) Effective March 31, 2008, RiverSource Emerging Markets Fund changed its name to Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund; RiverSource Global Equity Fund changed its name to Threadneedle Global Equity Fund; RiverSource European Equity Fund changed its name to Threadneedle European Equity Fund; RiverSource International Opportunity Fund changed its name to Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund; RiverSource International Aggressive Growth Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund; RiverSource International Select Value Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners International Select Value Fund; RiverSource International Small Cap Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund; RiverSource Fundamental Value Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund; RiverSource Small Cap Value Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund; RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Fundamental Value Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners Variable Portfolio – Fundamental Value Fund; RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Select Value Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners Variable Portfolio – Select Value Fund; and RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Small Cap Value Fund changed its name to RiverSource Partners Variable Portfolio – Small Cap Value Fund.
(12) Prior to January 2008, the assets of the funds in RiverSource Variable Series Trust were held by funds organized under six separate Minnesota Corporations.
(13) Effective June 8, 2005, Variable Portfolio – Inflation Protected Securities Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Global Inflation Protected Securities Fund.
(14) Prior to September 11, 2007, RiverSource Series Trust was known as RiverSource Retirement Series Trust.
(15) Prior to April 21, 2006, RiverSource Short Term Investments Series, Inc. was known as AXP Stock Series, Inc.
(16) Effective May 1, 2009, RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Growth Fund changed its name to Seligman Variable Portfolio – Growth Fund, RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Large Cap Equity Fund changed its name to RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Dynamic Equity Fund, RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Large Cap Value Fund changed its name to Seligman Variable Portfolio – Larger-Cap Value Fund, and RiverSource Variable Portfolio – Small Cap Advantage Fund changed its name to Seligman Variable Portfolio – Smaller-Cap Value Fund.
(17) Effective Sept. 25, 2009, Seligman Cash Management Fund, Inc. changed its name to RiverSource Government Money Market Fund, Inc.; Seligman LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund changed its name to RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund; and Seligman LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund changed its name to RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund.
(18) Effective May 1, 2010, RiverSource Partners Variable Portfolio – Fundamental Value Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Davis New York Venture Fund; RiverSource Partners Variable Portfolio – Select Value Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Goldman Sachs Mid Cap Value Fund; and RiverSource Partners Variable Portfolio – Small Cap Value Fund changed its name to Variable Portfolio – Partners Small Cap Value Fund.
(19) Effective Sept. 27, 2010, RiverSource Limited Duration Bond Fund changed its name to Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund; RiverSource Mid Cap Growth Fund changed its name to Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund; Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund changed its name to Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund; RiverSource Income Builder Basic Income Fund changed its name to Columbia Income Builder Fund; RiverSource Income Builder Moderate Income Builder Fund changed its name to Columbia Income Builder Fund II; RiverSource Income Builder Enhanced Fund changed its name to Columbia Income Builder Fund III; RiverSource

 

168


Table of Contents
 

Partners International Select Value Fund changed its name to Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund; Threadneedle Asia Pacific Fund changed its name to Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund; RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Growth Fund changed its name to Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund; RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund changed its name to Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund; RiverSource Mid Cap Value Fund changed its name to Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund; RiverSource Disciplined Equity Fund changed its name to Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund; RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund changed its name to Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund; RiverSource Cash Management Fund changed its name to Columbia Money Market Fund; RiverSource Tax-Exempt Bond Fund changed its name to Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund; Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc. changed its name to Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.; Seligman Global Technology Fund changed its name to Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund; Seligman Large-Cap Value Fund changed its name to Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund; and Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Fund changed its name to Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund.

 

169


Table of Contents

 

Board Members and Officers

Shareholders elect a Board that oversees a fund’s operations. The Board appoints officers who are responsible for day-to-day business decisions based on policies set by the Board. The following is a list of each fund’s Board members. Each Board member oversees 150 Columbia, RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds. Under current Board policy, members generally serve until the next regular shareholders’ meeting, until he or she reaches the mandatory retirement age established by the Board, or the fifteenth anniversary of the first Board meeting they attended as members of the Board.

On Nov. 7, 2008, Columbia Management announced the closing of its acquisition of J. & W. Seligman & Co. Incorporated (the “Seligman Acquisition”). In connection with the Seligman Acquisition, Messrs. Leroy C. Richie and John F. Maher, who were members of the Seligman funds’ Board prior to Nov. 7, 2008, began service on the Board after the Seligman Acquisition, which resulted in an overall increase from ten directors to twelve for all funds.

Table 26. Board Members

Independent Board Members*

 

Name, address, age

   Position held
with funds and
length of service
  

Principal occupation
during past five years

  

Other present or
past directorships
(within past 5 years)

  

Committee
memberships

Kathleen Blatz

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 56

   Board member

since 1/11/06

   Chief Justice, Minnesota Supreme Court, 1998-2006; Attorney    None    Board Governance, Compliance, Investment Review, Audit

Arne H. Carlson

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 76

   Board member

since 1/5/99

   Chair, RiverSource and Threadneedle funds, 1999-2006; former Governor of Minnesota    None    Board Governance, Compliance, Contracts, Executive, Investment Review

Pamela G. Carlton

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 56

   Board member

since 7/11/07

   President, Springboard-Partners in Cross Cultural Leadership (consulting company)    None    Distribution, Investment Review, Audit

Patricia M. Flynn

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 59

   Board member

since 11/1/04

   Trustee Professor of Economics and Management, Bentley University; former Dean, McCallum Graduate School of Business, Bentley University    None    Board Governance, Contracts, Investment Review

Anne P. Jones

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 75

   Board member

since 3/1/85

   Attorney and Consultant    None    Board Governance, Compliance, Executive, Investment Review, Audit

Jeffrey Laikind, CFA

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 75

   Board member

since 11/1/05

   Former Managing Director, Shikiar Asset Management    American Progressive Insurance; Hapoalim Securities USA, Inc.    Distribution, Executive, Investment Review, Audit

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 71

   Chair of the
Board since
1/1/07, Board

member since
1/1/02

   President Emeritus and Professor of Economics, Carleton College    Valmont Industries, Inc. (manufactures irrigation systems)    Board Governance, Compliance, Contracts, Executive, Investment Review

John F. Maher

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 67

   Board member

since 12/10/08

   Retired President and Chief Executive Officer and former Director, Great Western Financial Corporation (financial services), 1986-1997    None    Distribution, Investment Review, Audit

Catherine James Paglia

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 58

   Board member

since 11/1/04

   Director, Enterprise Asset Management, Inc. (private real estate and asset management company)    None    Board Governance, Compliance, Contracts, Executive, Investment Review

 

170


Table of Contents

Name, address, age

   Position held
with funds and
length of service
  

Principal occupation
during past five years

  

Other present or
past directorships
(within past 5 years)

  

Committee
memberships

Leroy C. Richie

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402

Age 69

   Board member
since 11/11/08
   Counsel, Lewis & Munday, P.C. since 2004; former Vice President and General Counsel, Automotive Legal Affairs, Chrysler Corporation    Digital Ally, Inc. (digital imaging); Infinity, Inc. (oil and gas exploration and production); OGE Energy Corp. (energy and energy services)    Contracts, Distribution, Investment Review

Alison Taunton-Rigby

901 S. Marquette Ave.

Minneapolis, MN 55402 Age 66

   Board member
since 11/13/02
   Chief Executive Officer and Director, RiboNovix, Inc. since 2003 (biotechnology); former President, Aquila Biopharmaceuticals    Idera Pharmaceuticals, Inc. (biotechnology); Healthways, Inc. (health management programs)    Contracts, Distribution, Executive, Investment Review

 

* Mr. Laikind may be deemed, as a technical matter, an interested person of RiverSource International Managers Series, Inc. because he serves as an independent director of a broker-dealer that has executed transactions for a subadviser to this fund.

Board Member Affiliated with the Investment Manager*

 

Name, address, age

   Position held
with funds and
length of service
  

Principal occupation
during past five years

   Other present or
past directorships
(within past 5 years)
  

Committee
memberships

William F. Truscott

53600 Ameriprise

Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age 50

   Board member
since 11/7/01,
Vice President
since 2002
   Chairman of the Board, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC) since May 2010 (previously President, Chairman of the Board and Chief Investment Officer, 2001-April 2010); Senior Vice president, Atlantic Funds, Columbia Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Chief Executive Officer, U.S. Asset Management & President – Annuities, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously President – U.S. Asset Management and Chief Investment Officer, 2005-April 2010 and Senior Vice President – Chief Investment Officer, 2001-2005); Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2006; Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) since May 2010 (previously Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, 2008-April 2010); Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006    None    None

 

* Interested person (as defined under the 1940 Act) by reason of being an officer, director, security holder and/or employee of the investment manager or Ameriprise Financial.

 

171


Table of Contents

 

The Board has appointed officers who are responsible for day-to-day business decisions based on policies it has established. The officers serve at the pleasure of the Board. In addition to Mr. Truscott, who is Vice President, the funds’ other officers are:

Table 27. Fund Officers

 

Name, address, age

   Position held
with funds and
length of service
  

Principal occupation
during past five years

J. Kevin Connaughton

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age 46

   President since 5/1/10    Senior Vice President and General Manager – Mutual Fund Products, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President, Columbia Funds since 2009 (previously Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, June 2008 - January 2009); President, Atlantic Funds and Nations Funds since 2009; Managing Director of Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, December 2004 - April 2010; Treasurer, Columbia Funds, October 2003 - May 2008; Treasurer, the Liberty Funds, Stein Roe Funds and Liberty All-Star Funds, December 2000 - December 2006; Senior Vice President – Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, April 2003 - December 2004; President, Columbia Funds, Liberty Funds and Stein Roe Funds, February 2004 - October 2004

Amy K. Johnson

5228 Ameriprise Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age 46

   Vice President since
12/5/06
   Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC) since May 2010 (previously Chief Administrative Officer, 2009 – April 2010 and Vice President – Asset Management and Trust Company Services, 2006–2009 and Vice President – Operations and Compliance, 2004-2006); Senior Vice President, Columbia Funds, Atlantic Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Director of Product Development – Mutual Funds, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., 2001-2004

Jeffrey P. Fox

105 Ameriprise Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age 55

   Treasurer since
7/10/02
   Chief Financial Officer, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) and of Seligman Data Corp. since 2008; Vice President – Investment Accounting, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since 2002; Chief Financial Officer, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006

Scott R. Plummer

5228 Ameriprise Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age 51

   Vice President,
General Counsel and
Secretary since
12/5/06
   Chief Legal Officer and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (formerly RiverSource Investments, LLC) since June 2005; Vice President and Lead Chief Counsel – Asset Management, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since May 2010 (previously Vice President and Chief Counsel – Asset Management, 2005-April 2010 and Vice President – Asset Management Compliance, 2004-2005); Senior Vice President, Secretary and Chief Legal Officer, Atlantic Funds, Columbia Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Vice President, Chief Counsel and Assistant Secretary, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) since 2008; Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, Ameriprise Certificate Company since 2005; Chief Counsel, RiverSource Distributors, Inc. since 2006; Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, USBancorp Asset Management, 2002-2004

Michael A. Jones

100 Federal Street

Boston, MA 02110

Age 51

   Vice President since
5/1/10
   Director and President, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; President and Director, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. since May 2010; Senior Vice President, Atlantic Funds, Columbia Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Manager, Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, 2007 – April 2010; Chief Executive Officer, President and Director, Columbia Management Distributors, Inc., 2006 – April 2010; former Co-President and Senior Managing Director, Robeco Investment Management

 

172


Table of Contents

Name, address, age

   Position held
with funds and
length of service
  

Principal occupation
during past five years

Colin Moore

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age 52

   Vice President since
5/1/10
   Chief Investment Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Senior Vice President, Atlantic Funds, Columbia Funds and Nations Funds since May 2010; Manager, Managing Director and Chief Investment Officer, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, 2007- April 2010; Head of Equities, Columbia Management Advisors, LLC, 2002-Sept. 2007

Linda Wondrack

One Financial Center

Boston, MA 02111

Age 46

   Chief Compliance Officer
since 5/1/10
   Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC since May 2010; Chief Compliance Officer, Columbia Funds since 2007; Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer, Atlantic Funds and Nations Funds since 2007; Director (Columbia Management Group, LLC and Investment Product Group Compliance), Bank of America, June 2005 - April 2010; Director of Corporate Compliance and Conflicts Officer, MFS Investment Management (investment management), August 2004 - May 2005

Neysa M. Alecu

2934 Ameriprise Financial Center

Minneapolis, MN 55474

Age 46

   Money Laundering
Prevention Officer since
11/9/05 and Identity Theft
Prevention Officer since
2008
   Vice President – Compliance, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since 2008; Anti-Money Laundering Officer and Identity Theft Prevention Officer, Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (formerly RiverSource Fund Distributors, Inc.) since 2008; Anti-Money Laundering Officer, Ameriprise Financial, Inc. since 2005; Compliance Director, Ameriprise Financial, Inc., 2004-2008;

Responsibilities of Board with respect to fund management

The Board is chaired by an Independent Director who has significant additional responsibilities compared to the other Board members, including, among other things: setting the agenda for Board meetings, communicating and meeting regularly with Board members between Board and committee meetings on fund-related matters with the funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, counsel to the Independent Directors, and representatives of the funds’ service providers and overseeing Board Services. The Board initially approves an Investment Management Services Agreement and other contracts with the investment manager and its affiliates, and other service providers. Once the contracts are approved, the Board monitors the level and quality of services including commitments of service providers to achieve expected levels of investment performance and shareholder services. In addition, the Board oversees that processes are in place to assure compliance with applicable rules, regulations and investment policies and addresses possible conflicts of interest. Annually, the Board evaluates the services received under the contracts by receiving reports covering investment performance, shareholder services, marketing, and the investment manager’s profitability in order to determine whether to continue existing contracts or negotiate new contracts. The Board also oversees fund risks, primarily through the functions (described below) performed by the Investment Review Committee, the Audit Committee and the Compliance Committee.

Committees of the Board

The Board has organized the following standing committees to facilitate its work: Board Governance Committee, Compliance Committee, Contracts Committee, Distribution Committee, Executive Committee, Investment Review Committee and Audit Committee. These Committees are comprised solely of Independent Directors (persons who are not “interested persons” of the fund as that term is defined in the 1940 Act. The table above describing each Director also includes their respective committee memberships. The duties of these committees are described below.

Mr. Lewis, as Chair of the Board, acts as a point of contact between the Independent Directors and the investment manager between Board meetings in respect of general matters.

Board Governance Committee — Recommends to the Board the size, structure and composition of the Board and its committees; the compensation to be paid to members of the Board; and a process for evaluating the Board’s performance. The committee also reviews candidates for Board membership including candidates recommended by shareholders. The committee also makes recommendations to the Board regarding responsibilities and duties of the Board, oversees proxy voting and supports the work of the Board Chair in relation to furthering the interests of the Funds and their shareholders on external matters. The committee also reviews candidates for Board membership, including candidates recommended by shareholders.

 

173


Table of Contents

 

To be considered as a candidate for director, recommendations must include a curriculum vitae and be mailed to the Chair of the Board, 901 Marquette Avenue South, Suite 2810, Minneapolis, MN 55402-3268. To be timely for consideration by the committee, the submission, including all required information, must be submitted in writing not less than 120 days before the date of the proxy statement for the previous year’s annual meeting of shareholders, if such a meeting is held. The committee will consider only one candidate submitted by such a shareholder or group for nomination for election at a meeting of shareholders. The committee will not consider self-nominated candidates or candidates nominated by members of a candidate’s family, including such candidate’s spouse, children, parents, uncles, aunts, grandparents, nieces and nephews.

The committee will consider and evaluate candidates submitted by the nominating shareholder or group on the basis of the same criteria as those used to consider and evaluate candidates submitted from other sources. The committee may take into account a wide variety of factors in considering director candidates, including (but not limited to): (i) the candidate’s knowledge in matters relating to the investment company industry; (ii) any experience possessed by the candidate as a director or senior officer of other public or private companies; (iii) the candidate’s educational background; (iv) the candidate’s reputation for high ethical standards and personal and professional integrity; (v) any specific financial, technical or other expertise possessed by the candidate, and the extent to which such expertise would complement the Board’s existing mix of skills and qualifications; (vi) the candidate’s perceived ability to contribute to the ongoing functions of the Board, including the candidate’s ability and commitment to attend meetings regularly, work collaboratively with other members of the Board and carry out his or her duties in the best interests of the fund; (vii) the candidate’s ability to qualify as an independent director; and (viii) such other criteria as the committee determines to be relevant in light of the existing composition of the Board and any anticipated vacancies or other factors.

Members of the committee (and/or the Board) also meet personally with each nominee to evaluate the candidate’s ability to work effectively with other members of the Board, while also exercising independent judgment. Although the Board does not have a formal diversity policy, the Board endeavors to comprise itself of members with a broad mix of professional and personal backgrounds. Thus, the committee and the Board accorded particular weight to the individual professional background of each Independent Director, as encapsulated in their bios included above in Table 26.

The Board believes that the funds are well-served by a Board, the membership of which consists of persons that represent a broad mix of professional and personal backgrounds. In considering nominations, the Committee takes the following matrix into account in assessing how a candidate’s professional background would fit into the mix of experiences represented by the then-current Board.

 

          PROFESSIONAL BACKGROUND — 2010

Name

   Geographic    For Profit;
CIO/CFO;
CEO/COO
   Non-Profit;
Government;
CEO
   Investment    Legal;
Regulatory
   Political    Academic    Distribution;
Marketing
   Audit
Committee;
Financial
Expert

Blatz

   MN       X       X    X         

Carlson

   MN       X          X         

Carlton

   NY          X    X             X

Flynn

   MA                   X      

Jones

   MD             X             X

Laikind

   NY    X       X             X    X

Lewis

   MN       X             X      

Maher

   CT    X       X                X

Paglia

   NY    X       X                X

Richie

   MI    X          X            

Taunton-Rigby

   MA    X       X                X

With respect to the directorship of Mr. Truscott, who is not an Independent Director, the committee and the Board have concluded that having a senior member of the investment manager serve on the Board can facilitate the Independent Directors’ increased access to information regarding the funds’ investment manager, which is the funds’ most significant service provider.

Compliance Committee — Supports the funds’ maintenance of a strong compliance program by providing a forum for Independent Directors to consider compliance matters impacting the Funds or their key service providers; developing and implementing, in coordination with the funds’ Chief Compliance Officer (CCO), a process for the review and consideration of compliance reports that are provided to the Boards; and providing a designated forum for the funds’ CCO to meet with Independent Directors on a regular basis to discuss compliance matters.

 

174


Table of Contents

 

Contracts Committee — Reviews and oversees the contractual relationships with service providers. Receives and analyzes reports covering the level and quality of services provided under contracts with the fund and advises the Board regarding actions taken on these contracts during the annual review process.

Distribution Committee — Reviews and supports product development, marketing, sales activity and practices related to the funds and will report to the Board as appropriate.

Executive Committee — Acts for the Board between meetings of the Board.

Investment Review Committee — Reviews and oversees the management of the funds’ assets. Considers investment management policies and strategies; investment performance; risk management techniques; and securities trading practices and reports areas of concern to the Board.

Audit Committee — Oversees the accounting and financial reporting processes of the funds and internal controls over financial reporting. Oversees the quality and integrity of the funds’ financial statements and independent audits as well as the funds’ compliance with legal and regulatory requirements relating to the funds’ accounting and financial reporting, internal controls over financial reporting and independent audits. The committee also makes recommendations regarding the selection of the funds’ independent auditor and reviews and evaluates the qualifications, independence and performance of the auditor. The committee oversees the funds’ risks by, among other things, meeting with the funds’ internal auditors, establishing procedures for the confidential, anonymous submission by employees of concerns about accounting or audit matters, and overseeing the funds’ Disclosure Controls and Procedures.

This table shows the number of times the committees met during each fund’s most recent fiscal period. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 28. Committee Meetings

 

Fiscal Period

   Board
Governance
Committee
     Compliance
Committee
     Contracts
Committee
     Distribution
Committee
     Executive
Committee
     Investment
Review
Committee
     Audit
Committee
 

For funds with fiscal period
ending January 31

     5         5         6         4         2         6         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending March 31

     5         5         6         4         1         5         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending April 30

     5         5         6         3         0         5         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending May 31

     5         5         6         3         0         5         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending June 30

     5         5         6         2         0         5         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending July 31

     5         5         6         2         0         5         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending August 31

     5         5         6         2         0         5         7   

For funds with fiscal period
ending September 30

     5         5         6         4         4         6         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending October 31

     5         5         6         4         3         6         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending November 30

     5         5         6         4         3         6         6   

For funds with fiscal period
ending December 31

     5         5         6         4         2         6         6   

 

175


Table of Contents

 

BOARD MEMBER HOLDINGS

The following table shows the Board members’ dollar range of equity securities beneficially owned on Dec. 31, 2009 of each individual fund owned by a Board member, and the aggregate dollar range of equity securities of all funds overseen by the Board members.

Table 29. Board Member Holdings

Based on net asset values as of Dec. 31, 2009:

 

Board Member

  

Fund

   Dollar range of
equity securities in
the fund
   Aggregate dollar range
of equity securities
of all Funds overseen by
Board Member

Kathleen Blatz

   Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income    $50,001-$100,000    Over $100,000
   Columbia Dividend Opportunity    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Income Opportunities Fund    $10,001-$50,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   RiverSource Partners Small Cap Growth    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value    $10,001-$50,000   
   RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining    $10,001-$50,000   
   RiverSource Real Estate    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Strategic Allocation    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communication and Information Fund    $10,001-$50,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Fund    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Threadneedle International Opportunity    Over $100,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   

Arne Carlson

   Columbia Money Market    Over $100,000    Over $100,000
   Columbia Dividend Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure    $1-$10,000   
   RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information    $10,001-$50,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   

 

176


Table of Contents

Board Member

  

Fund

   Dollar range of
equity securities in
the fund
   Aggregate dollar range
of equity securities
of all Funds overseen by
Board Member
 
Pamela Carlton    Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income    $1-$10,000      Over $100,000**   
   Columbia Money Market    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Diversified Equity Income    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Floating Rate*    $50,001-$100,000   
   RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government    $50,001-$100,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Global Equity    $1-$10,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   
Patricia M. Flynn    Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderately Aggressive*    $50,001-$100,000      Over $100,000*   
   Columbia Money Market*    $10,001-$50,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Strategic Allocation*    Over $100,000   
   Seligman Growth*    $50,000-$100,000   
   Threadneedle International Opportunity*    $50,001-$100,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $10,001-$50,000   
Anne P. Jones    Columbia Large Core Quantitative    $10,001-$50,000      Over $100,000   
   Columbia Diversified Bond    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Diversified Equity Income    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Global Bond    Over $100,000   
   Columbia High Yield Bond    Over $100,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government    Over $100,000   
   RiverSource Small Company Index    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Strategic Allocation    $50,001-$100,000   
   Seligman Growth    $10,001-$50,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Global Equity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   
Jeffrey Laikind    Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity    $50,001-$100,000      Over $100,000   
   Columbia Money Market    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Dividend Opportunity    $50,001-$100,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   

 

177


Table of Contents

Board Member

  

Fund

   Dollar range of
equity securities in
the fund
   Aggregate dollar range
of equity securities
of all Funds overseen by
Board Member
Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.    Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity    $10,001-$50,000    Over $100,000**
   Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income*    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Money Market*    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Diversified Bond*    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Diversified Equity Income*    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Dividend Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Bond    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Global Bond    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Large Growth Quantitative*    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Strategic Allocation    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information*    Over $100,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity*    $50,001-$100,000   
   Threadneedle Global Equity Income    $10,001-$50,000   
   Threadneedle International Opportunity*    $50,001-$100,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   
John F. Maher    Columbia Money Market    $10,001-$50,000    Over $100,000**
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information*    Over $100,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $10,001-$50,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $50,001-$100,000   
Catherine James Paglia    Columbia Money Market*    $10,001-$50,000    Over $100,000**
   Columbia Floating Rate*    Over $100,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   

 

178


Table of Contents

Board Member

  

Fund

   Dollar range of
equity securities in
the fund
   Aggregate dollar range
of equity securities
of all Funds overseen by
Board Member
 
Leroy C. Richie    RiverSource Balanced    $1-$10,000      Over $100,000   
   Columbia Large Core Quantitative    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Diversified Bond    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia High Yield Bond    $1-$10,000   
   RiverSource LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   RiverSource Partners International Select Growth    $1-$10,000   
   RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman Capital    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Frontier    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Seligman Global Technology    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman Growth    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Select Large-Cap Value    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Global Equity    $1-$10,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    Over $100,000   
Alison Taunton-Rigby    Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity    $10,001-$50,000      Over $100,000   
   Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Diversified Equity Income    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Over 100,000   
   Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity    $50,001-$100,000   
   RiverSource Partners International Select Growth    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Strategic Allocation    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information    $50,001-$100,000   
   Seligman Growth    $50,001-$100,000   
   Seligman LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $50,001-$100,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   

 

179


Table of Contents

Board Member

  

Fund

   Dollar range of
equity securities in
the fund
   Aggregate dollar range
of equity securities
of all Funds overseen by
Board Member
 
Ted Truscott    Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity    $50,001-$100,000    Over $ 100,000   
   Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Large Core Quantitative    Over $100,000   
   RiverSource Disciplined International Equity    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Large Growth Quantitative    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Large Value Quantitative    $50,001-$100,000   
   RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Diversified Bond    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Diversified Equity Income    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Dividend Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Bond    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Global Bond    Over $100,000   
   Columbia High Yield Bond    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Income Opportunities    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Inflation Protected Securities    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Limited Duration Credit    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity    $50,001-$100,000   
   RiverSource Partners International Select Growth    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    $50,001-$100,000   
   Columbia Retirement Plus 2035    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Strategic Allocation    Over $100,000   
   RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation    Over $100,000   
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Seligman Global Technology Seligman Growth    $10,001-$50,000   
   Seligman LaSalle International Real Estate    $1-$10,000   
   Seligman National Municipal Class    $1-$10,000   
   Columbia Seligman Premium Technology Growth    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000   
   Columbia Global Equity    Over $100,000   
   Tri-Continental Corporation    $1-$10,000   

 

180


Table of Contents

 

* Deferred compensation invested in share equivalents:

 

A. Carlton

   Columbia Money Market    $1-$10,000
   Columbia Floating Rate    $50,001-$100,000

B. Flynn

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderately Aggressive    $50,001-$100,000
   Columbia Money Market    $1-$10,000
   Seligman Growth    $50,001-$100,000
   Threadneedle International Opportunity    $10,001-$50,000

C. Lewis

   Columbia Money Market    $10,001-$50,000
   Columbia Diversified Bond    $1-$10,000
   Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income    $10,001-$50,000
   Columbia Large Growth Quantitative    $10,001-$50,000
   Columbia Diversified Equity Income    $50,001-$100,000
   Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity    $50,001-$100,000
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information    $50,001-$100,000
   Threadneedle International Opportunity    $50,001-$100,000

D. Maher

   Columbia Money Market    $10,001-$50,000
   Columbia Seligman Communications and Information    Over $100,000

E. Paglia

   Columbia Money Market    $10,001-$50,000
   Columbia Floating Rate    Over $100,000

 

** Total includes deferred compensation invested in share equivalents.

As of 30 days prior to the date of this SAI, the Board members and officers as a group owned 3.79% of Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund Class A, 1.08% of RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund Class A and 1.66% of Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund Class A. The Board members and officers as a group owned less than 1% of the outstanding shares of any class of any other Columbia, RiverSource, Seligman or Threadneedle fund.

COMPENSATION OF BOARD MEMBERS

Total compensation. The following table shows the total compensation paid to independent Board members from all the funds in the last fiscal period.

Table 30. Board Member Compensation – All Funds

 

Board member(a)

   Total Cash Compensation from
Funds Paid to Board member
 

Kathleen Blatz

   $ 194,765   

Arne H. Carlson

     210,399   

Pamela G. Carlton

     187,265 (b) 

Patricia M. Flynn

     200,994 (b) 

Anne P. Jones

     197,265   

Jeffrey Laikind

     200,566 (b) 

Stephen R. Lewis, Jr.

     391,959 (b) 

John F. Maher

     200,000 (b) 

Catherine James Paglia

     197,265   

Leroy Richie

     189,765   

Alison Taunton-Rigby

     189,765   

 

(a) Board member compensation is paid by the funds and is comprised of a combination of a base fee and meeting fees, with the exception of the Chair of the Board, who receives a base annual compensation. Payment of compensation is administered by a company providing limited administrative services to the funds and to the Board. Compensation noted in the table does not include amounts paid by Ameriprise Financial to Board members for attendance at Board and committee meetings relating to Ameriprise Financial’s acquisition of the long-term asset management business of Columbia Management Group, LLC, including certain of its affiliates. The Chair of the Board did not receive any such compensation from Ameriprise Financial.

 

(b) Ms. Carlton, Ms. Flynn, Mr. Laikind, Mr. Lewis and Mr. Maher elected to defer a portion of the total cash compensation payable during the period in the amount of $24,667, $92,667, $107,500, $77,333, and $200,000, respectively. Amount deferred by fund is set forth in Table 31. Additional information regarding the deferred compensation plan is described below.

The Independent Directors determine the amount of compensation that they receive, including the amount paid to the Chair of the Board. In determining compensation for the Independent Directors, the Independent Directors take into account a variety of factors including, among other things, their collective significant work experience (e.g., in business and finance, government or academia). The Independent Directors also recognize that these individuals’ advice and counsel are in demand

 

181


Table of Contents

by other organizations, that these individuals may reject other opportunities because the time demands of their duties as Independent Directors, and that they undertake significant legal responsibilities. The Independent Directors also consider the compensation paid to independent board members of other mutual fund complexes of comparable size. In determining the compensation paid to the Chair, the Independent Directors take into account, among other things, the Chair’s significant additional responsibilities (e.g., setting the agenda for Board meetings, communicating or meeting regularly with the Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer, Counsel to the Independent Directors, and the Funds’ service providers) which result in a significantly greater time commitment required of the Board Chair. The Chair’s compensation, therefore, has generally been set at a level between 2.5 and 3 times the level of compensation paid to other independent Board members.

Effective Jan. 1, 2010, independent Board members will be paid an annual retainer of $125,000. Committee and sub- committee Chairs each receive an additional annual retainer of $5,000. In addition, Independent Board Directors are paid the following fees for attending Board and committee meetings: $5,000 per day of in-person Board meetings and $2,500 per day of in-person committee or sub-committee meetings (if such meetings are not held on the same day as a Board meeting). Independent Directors are not paid for special meetings conducted by telephone. In 2010, the Board’s Chair will receive total annual cash compensation of $430,000.

The Independent Directors may elect to defer payment of up to 100% of the compensation they receive in accordance with a Deferred Compensation Plan (the Deferred Plan). Under the Deferred Plan, a Board member may elect to have his or her deferred compensation treated as if they had been invested in shares of one or more RiverSource, Seligman or Threadneedle funds in the Fund Family and the amount paid to the Board member under the Deferred Plan will be determined based on the performance of such investments. Distributions may be taken in a lump sum or over a period of years. The Deferred Plan will remain unfunded for federal income tax purposes under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. It is anticipated that deferral of Board member compensation in accordance with the Deferred Plan will have, at most, a negligible impact on fund assets and liabilities.

Compensation from each fund. The following table shows the compensation paid to independent Board members from each fund during its last fiscal period.

Table 31. Board Member Compensation — Individual Funds

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund  

Fund

  Blatz     Carlson     Carlton     Flynn     Jones     Laikind     Lewis     Maher     Paglia     Richie     Taunton-
Rigby
 

For funds with fiscal period ending January 31

  

             

Columbia Income Builder Fund

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

RiverSource S&P 500 Index — total

  $ 294      $ 303      $ 273      $ 282      $ 295      $ 273      $ 677      $ 265      $ 303      $ 282      $ 282   

Amount deferred

    0        0        96        91        0        25        105        265        0        0        0   

RiverSource Small Company Index — total

    928        954        862        887        928        862        2,129        834        954        887        887   

Amount deferred

    0        0        302        287        0        80        329        834        0        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending March 31

  

             

Columbia Equity Value — total

    1,720        1,744        1,604        1,653        1,744        1,604        3,776        1,561        1,744        1,629        1,629   

Amount deferred

    0        0        463        595        0        336        618        1,561        0        0        0   

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining — total

    354        359        330        339        359        330        776        321        358        335        335   

Amount deferred

    0        0        96        122        0        68        127        321        0        0        0   

 

182


Table of Contents

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund  

Fund

  Blatz     Carlson     Carlton     Flynn     Jones     Laikind     Lewis     Maher     Paglia     Richie     Taunton-
Rigby
 

For funds with fiscal period ending April 30

  

             

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity — total

  $ 103      $ 104      $ 97      $ 100      $ 104      $ 97      $ 221      $ 95      $ 104      $ 99      $ 99   

Amount deferred

    0        0        24        38        0        29        37        95        0        0        0   

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure — total

    912        929        869        903        929        869        1,880        853        929        886        886   

Amount deferred

    0        0        170        366        0        333        326        853        0        0        0   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

    *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *        *   

For funds with fiscal period ending May 31

  

             

Columbia High Yield Bond — total

    4,436        4,626        4,212        4,374        4,495        4,212        9,268        4,114        4,495        4,271        4,271   

Amount deferred

    0        0        890        1,720        0        1,490        1,594        4,114        0        0        0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value — total

    980        1,025        931        968        993        931        2,038        907        993        944        945   

Amount deferred

    0        0        196        381        0        330        350        907        0        0        0   

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage — total

    664        687        625        643        671        625        1,398        604        671        632        631   

Amount deferred

    0        0        160        239        0        170        233        604        0        0        0   

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value — total

    1,495        1,556        1,417        1,469        1,514        1,417        3,115        1,378        1,514        1,436        1,436   

Amount deferred

    0        0        314        570        0        474        532        1,378        0        0        0   

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government — total

    1,779        1,847        1,684        1,742        1,801        1,684        3,725        1,636        1,801        1,705        1,705   

Amount deferred

    0        0        384        672        0        544        633        1,636        0        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending June 30

  

             

Columbia Dividend Opportunity — total

    3,054        3,178        2,932        3,104        3,095        3,062        6,388        3,025        3,095        2,974        2,974   

Amount deferred

    0        0        534        1,327        0        1,329        1,167        3,025        0        0        0   

RiverSource Real Estate — total

    424        444        408        435        430        430        884        427        430        414        414   

Amount deferred

    0        0        69        190        0        199        164        427        0        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

  

             

Columbia Floating Rate — total

    1,013        1,076        972        1,032        1,027        1,017        2,116        1,011        1,027        986        986   

Amount deferred

    0        0        151        454        0        490        395        1,011        0        0        0   

Columbia Income Opportunities — total

    1,838        1,952        1,764        1,869        1,862        1,847        3,812        1,832        1,862        1,789        1,789   

Amount deferred

    0        0        271        826        0        898        714        1,832        0        0        0   

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities — total

    1,632        1,733        1,566        1,658        1,653        1,639        3,404        1,625        1,653        1,588        1,588   

Amount deferred

    0        0        244        731        0        790        636        1,625        0        0        0   

Columbia Large Core Quantitative — total

    10,069        10,674        9,637        10,207        10,203        10,076        20,381        10,019        10,203        9,771        9,771   

Amount deferred

    0        0        1,502        4,494        0        4,851        3,824        10,019        0        0        0   

Columbia Limited Duration Credit — total

    1,151        1,233        1,111        1,184        1,168        1,170        2,359        1,158        1,168        1,128        1,128   

Amount deferred

    0        0        145        539        0        620        453        1,158        0        0        0   

Columbia Money Market — total

    7,280        7,694        6,974        7,354        7,370        7,272        15,303        7,219        7,370        7,063        7,063   

Amount deferred

    0        0        1,162        3,195        0        3,350        2,824        7,219        0        0        0   

 

183


Table of Contents

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund  

Fund

  Blatz     Carlson     Carlton     Flynn     Jones     Laikind     Lewis     Maher     Paglia     Richie     Taunton-
Rigby
 

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity — total

  $ 340      $ 363      $ 327      $ 348      $ 345      $ 344      $ 706      $ 342      $ 345      $ 331      $ 331   

Amount deferred

    0        0        50        154        0        169        133        342        0        0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value — total

    123        131        119        126        125        125        254        124        125        120        120   

Amount deferred

    0        0        17        56        0        62        48        124        0        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending August 31

  

             

Columbia Diversified Bond — total

    10,872        11,740        10,452        11,219        11,014        11,180        21,928        11,153        11,014        10,593        10,593   

Amount deferred

    0        0        1,384        5,161        0        5,973        4,319        11,153        0        0        0   

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt — total

    827        891        794        851        837        847        1,665        845        838        804        804   

Amount deferred

    0        0        108        389        0        445        326        845        0        0        0   

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt — total

    389        417        373        398        394        396        782        395        394        377        377   

Amount deferred

    0        0        54        180        0        203        152        395        0        0        0   

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt — total

    135        145        129        138        136        137        271        137        136        131        131   

Amount deferred

    0        0        18        63        0        71        53        137        0        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending September 30

  

             

Columbia Diversified Equity Income — total

    11,145        11,437        10,376        10,768        11,145        10,376        24,962        7,460        11,656        9,314        10,667   

Amount deferred

    0        0        2,800        3,875        0        0        3,806        6,697        3,540        0        0   

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative — total

    952        977        883        913        952        882        2,194        730        988        850        908   

Amount deferred

    0        0        291        304        0        0        332        691        163        0        0   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative — total

    330        339        305        315        330        305        770        277        341        308        314   

Amount deferred

    0        0        116        97        0        0        116        273        18        0        0   

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity — total

    4,836        4,960        4,498        4,664        4,836        4,498        10,838        3,287        5,051        4,070        4,622   

Amount deferred

    0        0        1,242        1,665        0        0        1,651        2,970        1,461        0        0   

Columbia Strategic Allocation — total

    3,493        3,591        3,253        3,382        3,493        3,253        7,846        2,335        3,661        2,928        3,350   

Amount deferred

    0        0        873        1,219        0        0        1,197        2,091        1,124        0        0   

RiverSource Balanced — total

    1,543        1,585        1,436        1,491        1,543        1,436        3,469        1,042        1,614        1,297        1,477   

Amount deferred

    0        0        392        534        0        0        529        940        477        0        0   

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation — total

    544        559        505        523        544        506        1,238        397        567        475        520   

Amount deferred

    0        0        155        179        0        0        188        369        123        0        0   

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield — total

    86        89        79        75        86        80        194        74        73        82        82   

Amount deferred

    0        0        25        20        0        0        25        68        0        0        0   

Seligman California Municipal Quality — total

    101        105        93        88        101        94        228        87        86        97        97   

Amount deferred

    0        0        30        23        0        0        29        20        0        0        0   

Seligman Minnesota Municipal — total

    170        176        156        148        170        157        382        146        145        162        162   

Amount deferred

    0        0        50        39        0        0        0        134        0        0        0   

 

184


Table of Contents

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund  

Fund

  Blatz     Carlson     Carlton     Flynn     Jones     Laikind     Lewis     Maher     Paglia     Richie     Taunton-
Rigby
 

Seligman National Municipal — total

  $ 625      $ 643      $ 582      $ 587      $ 624      $ 582      $ 1,494      $ 528      $ 615      $ 600      $ 600   

Amount deferred

    0        0        221        171        0        0        216        517        0        0        0   

Seligman New York Municipal — total

    187        194        173        165        187        173        425        162        164        179        179   

Amount deferred

    0        0        57        44        0        0        55        150        0        0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2015 — total

    61        62        56        52        61        56        134        52        50        58        58   

Amount deferred

    0        0        17        14        0        0        16        47        0        0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2025 — total

    69        71        64        60        69        64        154        59        58        66        66   

Amount deferred

    0        0        20        16        0        0        19        54        0        0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2035 — total

    18        19        17        16        19        17        42        16        16        18        18   

Amount deferred

    0        0        0        0        0        0        5        15        0        0        0   

Seligman TargETFund 2045 — total

    10        10        9        8        10        9        23        9        9        10        10   

Amount deferred

    0        0        3        2        0        0        0        8        0        0        0   

Seligman TargETFund Core — total

    136        140        125        116        136        125        301        116        112        129        129   

Amount deferred

    0        0        39        30        0        0        37        105        0        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending October 31

  

             

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income — total

    1,356        1,410        1,252        1,322        1,356        1,252        3,201        1,017        1,446        1,306        1,306   

Amount deferred

    0        0        366        459        0        0        490        891        364        0        0   

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan(a) — total

    22        22        20        21        22        20        60        20        22        20        20   

Amount deferred

    0        0        8        6        0        0        9        20        0        0        0   

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond — total

    465        477        430        447        465        430        1,118        363        486        443        442   

Amount deferred

    0        0        137        150        0        0        170        330        94        0        0   

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity — total

    878        898        814        841        878        814        2,144        703        912        835        835   

Amount deferred

    0        0        275        276        0        0        325        656        137        0        0   

Columbia European Equity — total

    161        166        149        155        161        149        385        125        169        153        153   

Amount deferred

    0        0        47        52        0        0        59        113        34        0        0   

Columbia Frontier — total

    89        92        83        77        89        82        205        76        75        85        85   

Amount deferred

    0        0        26        20        0        0        26        70        0        0        0   

Columbia Global Bond — total

    1,293        1,329        1,196        1,246        1,293        1,196        3,068        970        1,361        1,232        1,232   

Amount deferred

    0        0        361        428        0        0        469        866        318        0        0   

Columbia Global Equity — total

    1,092        1,124        1,010        1,052        1,092        1,010        2,613        855        1,145        1,043        1,043   

Amount deferred

    0        0        325        352        0        0        398        780        213        0        0   

Columbia Global Extended Alpha — total

    16        16        14        15        16        15        38        12        16        15        15   

Amount deferred

    0        0        5        5        0        0        6        11        3        0        0   

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value — total

    2,143        2,201        1,983        2,062        2,143        1,983        5,121        1,674        2,245        2,042        2,042   

Amount deferred

    0        0        633        693        0        0        780        1,518        432        0        0   

Columbia Seligman Global Technology — total

    673        691        622        595        672        622        1,581        583        594        640        640   

Amount deferred

    0        0        209        162        0        0        210        545        0        0        0   

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity — total

    908        931        840        873        908        840        2,166        699        951        863        863   

Amount deferred

    0        0        260        297        0        0        331        625        206        0        0   

 

185


Table of Contents

 

    Aggregate Compensation from Fund  

Fund

  Blatz     Carlson     Carlton     Flynn     Jones     Laikind     Lewis     Maher     Paglia     Richie     Taunton-
Rigby
 

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth — total

  $ 903      $ 929      $ 836      $ 870      $ 903      $ 836      $ 2,159      $ 703      $ 947      $ 861      $ 861   

Amount deferred

    0        0        266        293        0        0        329        637        186        0        0   

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap — total

    124        128        115        120        124        115        299        98        130        119        119   

Amount deferred

    0        0        37        40        0        0        46        89        24        0        0   

Threadneedle Global Equity Income — total

    54        55        50        52        54        50        131        44        56        52        52   

Amount deferred

    0        0        17        17        0        0        20        41        7        0        0   

Threadneedle International Opportunity — total

    902        927        835        869        902        835        2,163        709        945        861        861   

Amount deferred

    0        0        268        291        0        0        329        642        178        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending November 30

  

             

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond — total

    1,649        1,703        1,526        1,586        1,649        1,526        3,963        1,467        1,715        1,580        1,580   

Amount deferred

    0        0        560        499        0        0        599        1,353        126        0        0   

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity — total

    1,441        1,479        1,332        1,375        1,441        1,332        3,423        1,277        1,489        1,370        1,370   

Amount deferred

    0        0        495        430        0        0        517        1,193        94        0        0   

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt — total

    220        227        203        211        219        203        527        195        228        210        210   

Amount deferred

    0        0        75        66        0        0        80        181        16        0        0   

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income — total

    5,635        5,818        5,215        5,420        5,635        5,215        13,540        5,012        5,860        5,399        5,399   

Amount deferred

    0        0        1,915        1,705        0        0        2,046        4,627        427        0        0   

For funds with fiscal period ending December 31

  

             

Columbia Government Money Market — total

    348        363        323        338        349        323        828        313        363        338        338   

Amount deferred

    0        0        129        101        0        0        124        313        0        0        0   

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value — total

    497        507        463        473        497        463        1,143        445        507        473        473   

Amount deferred

    0        0        185        142        0        0        172        445        0        0        0   

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value — total

    463        472        429        437        463        429        1,019        420        472        437        437   

Amount deferred

    0        0        172        131        0        0        153        420        0        0        0   

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information — total

    7,421        7,621        6,888        7,087        7,421        6,888        17,086        6,672        7,621        7,087        7,087   

Amount deferred

    0        0        2,755        2,126        0        0        2,563        6,672        0        0        0   

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate — total

    31        32        29        30        31        29        71        28        32        29        29   

Amount deferred

    0        0        12        9        0        0        11        28        0        0        0   

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate — total

    60        62        56        57        60        56        139        54        62        58        58   

Amount deferred

    0        0        22        17        0        0        21        54        0        0        0   

 

186


Table of Contents
    Aggregate Compensation from Fund  

Fund

  Blatz     Carlson     Carlton     Flynn     Jones     Laikind     Lewis     Maher     Paglia     Richie     Taunton-
Rigby
 

Seligman Capital — total

  $ 530      $ 545      $ 491      $ 507      $ 530      $ 491      $ 1,228      $ 476      $ 545      $ 507      $ 507   

Amount deferred

    0        0        197        152        0        0        184        476        0        0        0   

Seligman Growth — total

    1,806        1,825        1,672        1,690        1,806        1,672        3,803        1,654        1,825        1,690        1,690   

Amount deferred

    0        0        669        507        0        0        570        1,654        0        0        0   

 

* The Funds-of-Funds do not pay additional compensation to the Board members for attending meetings. Compensation is paid directly from the affiliated underlying funds in which each Fund-of-Funds invests.
(a) For the period from July 15, 2009 (when shares became publicly available) to Oct. 31, 2009.

The funds, Columbia Management, unaffiliated and affiliated subadvisers, and Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. have each adopted a Code of Ethics (collectively, the “Codes”) and related procedures reasonably designed to prevent violations of Rule 204A-1 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 and Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act. The Codes contain provisions reasonably necessary to prevent a fund’s access persons from engaging in any conduct prohibited by paragraph (b) of Rule 17j-1, which indicates that it is unlawful for any affiliated person of or principal underwriter for a fund, or any affiliated persons of an investment adviser of or principal underwriter for a fund, in connection with the purchase or sale, directly or indirectly, by the person of a security held or to be acquired by a fund (i) to employ any device, scheme or artifice to defraud a fund; (ii) to make any untrue statement of a material fact to a fund or omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements made to a fund, in light of the circumstance under which they are made, not misleading; (iii) to engage in any act, practice or course of business that operates or would operate as a fraud or deceit on a fund; or (iv) to engage in any manipulative practice with respect to a fund. The Codes prohibit personnel from engaging in personal investment activities that compete with or attempt to take advantage of planned portfolio transactions for the funds.

Copies of the Codes are on public file with the SEC and can be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room in Washington, DC. The information on the operation of the SEC’s Public Reference Room may be obtained by calling the SEC at 1-202-942-8090. Copies of the Codes are also available on the EDGAR Database on the SEC’s Internet site at www.sec.gov. Copies of the Codes may also be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request at the following e-mail address: publicinfo@sec.gov, or by writing the SEC’s Public Reference Section, Washington, DC 20549-0102.

 

187


Table of Contents

 

Control Persons and Principal Holders of Securities

The following table identifies those investors who, as of 30 days after the end of the fund’s fiscal period, owned 5% or more of any class of a fund’s shares and those investors who owned 25% or more of a fund’s shares (all share classes taken together). Investors who own more than 25% of a fund’s shares are presumed under securities laws to control the fund and would be able to determine the outcome of most issues that are submitted to shareholders for vote. The table is organized by fiscal year end. You can find your fund’s fiscal year end in Table 1.

Table 32. Control Persons and Principal Holders of Securities

As of 30 days after the end of the fund’s fiscal period:

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class      Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

Funds with fiscal period ending January 31

       

Columbia Income Builder Fund

   Charles Schwab & Co., Inc. (Charles Schwab) a brokerage firm in San Francisco, CA      Class A         24.34     —     
   Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (Columbia Management), Minneapolis, MN      Class R4         100.00     —     

Columbia Income Builder Fund II

   Charles Schwab      Class A         30.24     26.31 %(a) 
        Class R4         48.17  
   Columbia Management      Class R4         51.83     —     

Columbia Income Builder Fund III

   Charles Schwab      Class A         30.62     26.58 %(a) 
        Class R4         74.05  
   Columbia Management      Class R4         25.95     —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive

   Wells Fargo Bank NA (Wells Fargo Bank), Minneapolis, MN      Class R4         52.43     —     
   Charles Schwab      Class R4         30.18     —     
   GWFS Equities Inc. (GWFS Equities), Greenwood Village, CO      Class R4         12.50     —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative

   Charles Schwab      Class A         5.32     —     
        Class R4         20.85  
   Wells Fargo Bank      Class R4         59.72     —     
   Columbia Management      Class R4         13.92     —     
   GWFS Equities      Class R4         5.24     —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate

   Charles Schwab      Class R4         54.79     —     
   Wells Fargo Bank      Class R4         32.25     —     
   MG Trust Company Cust. FBO Becker Tire & Treading, Inc., Denver, CO      Class R4         9.17     —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive

   Charles Schwab      Class R4         73.17     —     
   Fifth Third Bank TTEE, Cincinnati, OH      Class R4         11.66     —     
   MG Trust Company Cust. FBO Becker Tire & Treading, Inc., Denver, CO      Class R4         7.96     —     
   Wells Fargo Bank      Class R4         5.64     —     

 

188


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative

   Charles Schwab    Class R4      57.77     —     
   Columbia Management    Class R4      30.33     —     
   Wells Fargo Bank    Class R4      11.90     —     

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity

   Wells Fargo Bank    Class R4      52.82     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class R4      43.75     —     

RiverSource S&P 500 Index

   Charles Schwab    Class A      100.00     35.16 %(a) 
      Class Z      21.47  
   Wachovia Bank NA (Wachovia Bank), Charlotte, NC    Class Z      78.44     64.76 %(a) 

RiverSource Small Company Index

   Charles Schwab    Class A      6.24     —     
      Class R4      5.65  
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      80.56     —     

Funds with fiscal period ending March 31

       

Columbia Equity Value

   Charles Schwab    Class A      5.37     —     
   Columbia Management    Class R      21.35     —     
      Class R5      100.00     —     
      Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      17.81     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.96     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.71     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.55     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      17.70     —     
   MG Trust Company, FBO Alumaline Corp. of America, Denver, CO    Class R      71.11     —     
   Frontier Trust Company, FBO Aurora Packing Company 401K, Fargo, ND    Class R      7.54     —     
   John Hancock Life Insurance Company, Buffalo, NY    Class R4      74.65     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R3      96.49     —     
      Class R4      19.20     —     

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining

   Charles Schwab    Class A      12.26     —     
      Class R4      57.96     —     
   Columbia Management    Class I      100.00     —     
   Merrill Lynch Pierce Fenner & Smith (MLP Fenner & Smith), Jacksonville, FL    Class C      13.50     —     
   Frontier Trust Company, FBO Jacinto Medical Group PA 401K, Fargo, ND    Class R4      32.22     —     
   MG Trust Company, FBO Saddle Butte Operating, Denver, CO    Class R4      7.99     —     

Funds with fiscal period ending April 30

       

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity

   Columbia Management    Class I      100.00     —     
      Class R5      100.00  

 

189


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure

   Columbia Management    Class R      24.00     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R5      33.12  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      17.50     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate    Class I      26.33     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    Class I      29.60     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative    Class I      6.80     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      17.31     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class R5      66.86     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Brian P. Sommer    Class R      75.00     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc. (American Enterprise Investment Services), Minneapolis, MN    Class R4      29.19     —     
   NFS LLC FEBO Cisco Systems Inc., Acton, MA    Class R4      5.96     —     

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      100.00     63.98 %(a) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      100.00     76.23 %(a) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   David T. Matthiesen, Littleton, CO    Class A      8.38     —     
   MG Trust Company FBO Applied Reliability Engineering, Denver, CO    Class R      80.49     —     
   Matrix Capital Bank MSCS (Matrix Capital), Denver, CO    Class R      14.86     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      100.00     75.54 %(a) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025

   Columbia Management    Class R      16.35     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Eric Taketa, Wailuku, Hi    Class A      8.10     —     
   Anthony D. and Rebecca H. Marken, Lexington, MA    Class A      5.78     —     
   Matrix Capital    Class R      83.64     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      100.00     87.25 %(a) 

 

190


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030

   Columbia Management    Class R      31.82     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   John C. Bukowski, Suffern, NY    Class A      10.12     —     
   Steven and Teresa Bockian, Orlando, FL    Class A      5.89     —     
   MG Trust Company FBO Applied Reliability Engineering, Denver, CO    Class R      68.18     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      100.00     87.56 %(a) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Gary L. and Karen L. Fournier, Vicksburg, MS    Class A      7.30     —     
   Richard and Stefanie A. Nelson, Hot Springs, SD    Class A      5.23     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      99.87     89.55 %(a) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040

   Columbia Management    Class R      32.46     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Matrix Capital    Class R      67.53     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      98.82     86.36 %(a) 

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045

   Columbia Management    Class R      82.98     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      28.19  
      Class R5      100.00  
   MG Trust Company FBO Applied Reliability Engineering, Denver, CO    Class R      17.02     —     
   Scottrade Inc. FBO Michael C. Davis, St. Louis, MO    Class R4      71.81     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Z      100.00     88.66 %(a) 

Funds with fiscal period ending May 31

       

Columbia High Yield Bond

   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      14.76     —     
      Class R      69.10  
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      21.74     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      37.23     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      23.77     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class W      99.99     —     
   ING Life Insurance and Annuity (ING), Hartford, CT    Class R3      89.20     —     
      Class R4      93.78  
   Massachusetts Mutual    Class R3      6.29     —     
   US Bank National Association, Milwaukee, WI    Class R5      99.52     —     

 

191


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      16.51     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      30.26     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      33.96     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      7.68     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      8.91     —     
   Christa Fischer FBO Photo Systems Inc. 401K, Dexter, MI    Class R      5.94     —     
   Robert Guglielmo FBO Grid Electric Inc. 401K. Chester Springs, PA    Class R      5.16     —     
   Hartford Life Insurance Company (Hartford Life), Weatogue, CT    Class R      84.79     —     
      Class R3      21.70  
   PIMS/Prudential Retirement, Boston, MA    Class R3      66.20     —     
   Reliance Trust Co. FBO VHFA, Atlanta, GA    Class R3      7.83     —     
   VRSCO FBO Pullman Regional Hospital, Houston, TX    Class R4      41.18     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      30.00     —     
   Edward Dopkin FBO Classic Catering People Inc., Owings Mills, MD    Class R4      5.74     —     
   JP Morgan Chase Bank, Kansas City, MO    Class R5      99.94     —     

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage

   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      25.69     55.94 %(a) 
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      31.90     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      11.28     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      12.20     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      7.16     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      5.80     —     
   RiverSource Life Insurance Company, Minneapolis, MN    Class R4      12.12     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      5.25     —     
   Counsel Trust FBO Harvard Mgmt Solutions, Pittsburgh, PA    Class R4      30.76     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      30.75     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO URY & Moskow LLC, Fargo, ND    Class R4      17.70     —     

 

192


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      17.66     32.17 %(a) 
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      26.20     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.64     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.66     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      17.53     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      83.80     —     
   Columbia Management    Class R4      5.73     —     

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government

   Columbia Management    Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund    Class I      43.31     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      39.88     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      16.80     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class R      79.26     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO North Alabama Insurance, Fargo, ND    Class R      7.93     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      98.92     —     

Funds with fiscal period ending June 30

       

Columbia Dividend Opportunity

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      10.12     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      19.29     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      8.56     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      10.93     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      16.35     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.32     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      10.80     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class R      97.90     —     
   VRSCO FBO Hamilton Healthcare, Houston, TX    Class R4      64.38     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      6.76     —     
   Securian Financial Services, St. Paul, MN    Class R5      38.12     —     
   Counsel Trust FBO Bennett Tueller Johnson & Deere, Pittsburgh, PA    Class R5      15.11     —     
   TD Ameritrade Trust Co., Denver CO    Class R5      13.55     —     
   Counsel Trust FBO Western Gynecological Clinic, Pittsburgh, PA    Class R5      12.04     —     
   Counsel Trust FBO Utah Woolen Mills Profit Sharing Plan, Pittsburgh, PA    Class R5      12.01     —     
   NFS LLC FEBO Sylvia C San Martin TTEE, St. Augustine, FL    Class R5      7.89     —     

 

193


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

RiverSource Real Estate

   Columbia Management    Class R4      12.42     68.41 %(a) 
      Class W      100.00  
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      13.28     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      10.48     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      9.81     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      23.04     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.72     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      8.24     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      8.21     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      87.58     —     

For funds with fiscal period ending July 31

       

Columbia Floating Rate

   Columbia Management    Class R5      100.00     27.75 %(a) 
      Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      12.28     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      35.22     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      21.95     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      12.95     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      9.21     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.17     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      6.52     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.19     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      64.03        —     
   NFS LLC FEBO American Trust & Svgs, Dubuque, IA    Class R4      7.31     —     

Columbia Income Opportunities

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      5.58     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      39.73     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      22.91     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      18.80     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      6.41     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class B      6.32     —     
      Class C      8.83     —     
   Morgan Stanley Smith Barney, Jersey City, NJ    Class C      7.78     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      12.78     —     
   GWFS Equities    Class R4      84.82     —     

 

194


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities

   RiverSource Life Insurance Company, Minneapolis, MN    Class R4      13.62     31.95 %(a) 
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      9.81     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      9.74     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund    Class I      10.06     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      28.92     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      16.65     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      13.74     —     
   Citigroup Global Markets, Owings Mills, MD    Class C      15.08     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.31     —     
      Class R      64.40     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO Moen 401K, Fargo, ND    Class R      5.97     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO B & L Corp. 401K, Fargo, ND    Class R      5.91     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO C. Anthony Phillips Accountancy, Fargo, ND    Class R      5.91     —     
   Matrix Capital Bank MSCS, Denver, Co    Class R4      68.92     —     
   RiverSource Life Insurance Co.    Class R4      7.21     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class W      99.96     —     

Columbia Large Core Quantitative

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderate Fund    Class I      6.94     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      10.92     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      16.57     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.58     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      10.77     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class W      99.99     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.73     —     
      Class R      78.57     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      95.66     —     
      Class R5      99.91     —     

Columbia Limited Duration Credit

   Columbia Management    Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund    Class I      38.30     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      13.20     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      7.60     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      35.57     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.58     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class R4      85.91     —     

 

195


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

Columbia Money Market

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      35.70     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund    Class I      52.27     —     
   Columbia Management    Class B      6.67     —     
   Columbia Management    Class C      28.62     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO Mythics, Inc. 401K, Fargo, ND    Class R5      54.23     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO Greatmats.com Corp., Fargo, ND    Class R5      30.29     —     
   Counsel Trust DBA MATC FBO Harvard Management Solutions 401K, Pittsburgh, PA    Class R5      5.67     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class W      99.99     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class Y      99.67     —     
   Columbia Management    Class Z      99.97     —     

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity

   Columbia Management    Class R4      82.91     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Aggressive Fund    Class I      7.82     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderate Fund    Class I      22.13     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderately Aggressive Fund    Class I      16.28     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderately Conservative Fund    Class I      8.42     —     
   Columbia Retirement Plus Fund 2020    Class I      5.77     —     
   Columbia Retirement Plus Fund 2025    Class I      7.60     —     
   Columbia Retirement Plus Fund 2030    Class I      7.31     —     
   Columbia Retirement Plus Fund 2035    Class I      5.60     —     
   Brian C. Burghardt, Glendale, WI    Class B      6.39     —     
   Louiselle A. Pilegi, Agawam,MA    Class B      6.21     —     
   Jennifer Woolbright, Reston, VA    Class C      14.29     —     
   Carl L. and Vicki L. Ulepich, Frontenac, KS    Class C      10.98     —     
   Patrick J. and Edilia I. Powers, Forest Park, IL    Class C      9.95     —     
   Mary Caroline Walsh Murguia, San Antonio, TX    Class C      7.45     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R4      17.09     —     
      Class W      99.99     —     

 

196


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        
                Percent of Fund  

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     (if greater than 25%)  

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value

   Columbia Management    Class B      6.09     91.93 %(a) 
      Class C      6.42  
      Class R      100.00  
      Class R3      67.31  
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      29.39     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      46.90     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      23.69     —     
   Eric B. and Lucilla Henderson, Lake Jackson, TX    Class B      9.49     —     
   Doris M. Tole, Pittsburgh, PA    Class B      9.21     —     
   Kenneth E. Farnen, Homer, AK    Class B      9.01     —     
   Marilyn A. and Gary F. Consorto, Vonore, TN    Class B      6.13     —     
   Donald R. Chmielewski, Isle, MN    Class B      5.65     —     
   Morgan Stanley Smith Barney, Jersey City, NJ    Class C      20.08     —     
   Sanford A. Greentree, Westlake Vlg, CA    Class C      19.83     —     
   Jill Thompson, Moundsview, MN    Class C      9.29     —     
   Bea Vande Merwe, Salt Lake City, UT    Class C      9.07     —     
   Timothy E. Releford, New York, NY    Class C      8.66     —     
   Richard T. Castiano, Fort Myers, FL    Class C      7.81     —     
   MG Trust Company, Denver, CO    Class R3      32.69     —     

Funds with fiscal period ending August 31

       

Columbia Diversified Bond

   Columbia Management    Class R3      93.14     —     
      Class W      100.00  
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class W      99.99     —     
   Citigroup Global Markets, Owings Mills, MD    Class C      29.63     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      15.31     —     
      Class R      52.20     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund    Class I      6.41     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      34.21     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      20.02     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      10.17     —     
   MG Trust Company, Denver, CO    Class R      15.70     —     
   Frontier Trust Co. FBO Thomas J. King, Fargo, ND    Class R      12.89     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      99.08     —     
   Patricks Plain,Easton, MD    Class R5      55.69     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R5      39.90     —     

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt

   Leonard and Marion Hoppe, Graceville, MN    Class B      6.59     —     
   Richard J. and Mary H. Hill, St. Louis Park, MN    Class B      6.41     —     
   Lois Drontle, Eden Prairie, MN    Class B      5.20     —     

 

197


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt

   First Clearing, LLC, Moss Family Trust, Descan SO, CA    Class A      11.83     —     
   ETrade Clearing LLC, Merrifield, VA    Class A      7.41     —     
   Sara L. Oswald, San Diego, CA    Class A      6.29     —     
   Kathleen Scopaz, San Clemente, CA    Class B      17.51     —     
   Angelo Bomio, Salinas, CA    Class B      12.52     —     
   Gerald L. and JoAnne Karels, Tulare, CA    Class B      8.89     —     
   Columbia Management    Class B      8.69     —     
   Miriam A. and Myrin C. Wilcox, Porterville, CA    Class B      6.15     —     
   Brian W. Robins, San Diego, CA    Class B      5.17     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class C      26.91  
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      5.96  

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt

   Jeffrey B. Seller, New York, NY    Class A      7.67     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Service    Class A      6.28     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class B      25.97     —     
   Edward Ebler, Babylon, NY    Class B      15.14     —     
   Sharon Ganz, Forest Hills, NY    Class B      12.89     —     
   Vincent J. Solimine, Glen Cove, NY    Class B      7.80     —     
   Richard Clark, Somers, NY    Class B      5.11     —     
   Thomas W. and Susan M. Noonan, Clifton Park, Ny    Class C      43.74     —     
   Ena S. Ryan, Brooklyn, NY    Class C      22.49     —     
   Frederic I. Nelson, Oceanside, NY    Class C      16.15     —     
   Ottoviano Asarese, Buffalo, NY    Class C      15.07     —     
   Joseph P. and Cynthia A. Dowd, Wynantskill, NY    Class C      14.46     —     
   James H. Sisung, Staatsburg, NY    Class C      13.47     —     
   James R. And Kelly S. Betters, Leroy, NY    Class C      12.01     —     
   Arthur E. and Gertrude Kranz, S. Farmingdale, NY    Class C      11.76     —     
   Christopher Paul Pellegrini, Rye, NY    Class C      11.58     —     
   First Clearing LLC, St. Louis, MO    Class C      11.17     —     
   Melinda and James Coates, Rego Park, NY    Class C      10.19     —     
   Lauren M. Trotta, New York, NY    Class C      10.02     —     

 

198


Table of Contents

 

     Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class      Percentage    

Funds with fiscal period ending September 30

       

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative

   Columbia Management      Class R         100.00     29.22 %(a) 
        Class R3         100.00  
        Class R4         73.56  
        Class R5         100.00  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund      Class I         14.51     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund      Class I         19.98     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund      Class I         23.99     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund      Class I         5.01     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund      Class I         14.91     —     
   Matrix Capital      Class R4         26.44     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith      Class C         47.00     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.      Class W         99.99     —     

Columbia Large Value Quantitative

   Columbia Management      Class B         13.40     —     
        Class C         28.20  
        Class R         100.00  
        Class R3         100.00  
        Class R4         56.29  
        Class R5         100.00  
   Columbia Income Builder Fund      Class I         18.55     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II      Class I         11.47     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolio Moderate      Class I         17.40     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolio Moderately Aggressive      Class I         13.26     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolio Moderately Conservative      Class I         7.55     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Portfolio Aggressive      Class I         6.44     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.      Class W         99.99     —     
   Charles Schwab      Class A         5.22     —     
        Class R4         43.71  
   Paul W. Eastman, Dublin, OH      Class A         7.20     —     
   Michael G. and Kristine M. Boland, Inver Grove, MN      Class A         6.73     —     
   Richard L. and Ann Gail Monnett, Mc Lean, VA      Class A         6.44     —     
   Paul D. Mattingly, Brandenburg, KY      Class B         25.36     —     
   Tseng-Yen Yen, Fullerton, CA      Class B         20.47     —     
   Alan R. and Michael S. Vinacke, Chuluota, FL      Class B         19.00     —     
   Jane J. Haash, Milwaukee, WI      Class B         6.33     —     
   Joseph M. Aquilar, Denver, CO      Class C         19.21     —     
   Charles P. and Judith G. Price, Aurora, CO      Class C         15.16     —     
   Gregory L. Norgaard, Aurora, CO      Class C         14.00     —     
   Anthony and Jeanne M. Vernell, Athens, OH      Class C         13.16     —     
   Dean Gabbert, Dorchester, MA      Class C         5.50     —     

 

199


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Diversified Equity Income

   Columbia Management    Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.11     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      24.95     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.91     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.26     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.60     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      21.38     —     
   Hartford Life    Class R      61.20     —     
   Hartford Securities Distribution Company Inc., Hartford, CT    Class R      12.22     —     
   GWFS Equities    Class R3      80.99     —     
      Class R4      9.55  
   Wachovia Bank    Class R      17.75     —     
      Class R3      8.52  
      Class R4      30.99  
      Class R5      29.75  
   Wells Fargo Bank    Class R4      25.70     —     
   American Century Investments, Kansas City, MO    Class R4      6.24     —     
   ING    Class R4      12.55     —     
      Class R5      32.31  
   Ameriprise Trust Company    Class R5      7.85     —     
   Taynik & Co., Boston, MA    Class R5      7.73     —     
   Mercer Trust Company FBO Johnson Outdoors Inc., Norwood, MA    Class R5      7.45     —     

 

200


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity

   Columbia Management    Class W      100.00     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.14     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.01     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.79     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.26     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.62     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      31.64     —     
      Class R5      6.65  
   Prudential Investment Management Services LLC, Newark, NJ    Class A      15.08     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      17.57     —     
      Class R5      5.28  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class C      5.60     —     
   Hartford Life    Class R      75.44     —     
      Class R3      14.09  
   Hartford Securities Distribution Company Inc., Hartford, CT    Class R      5.41     —     
   JPMorgan Chase Bank, New York, NY    Class R3      12.25     —     
   GWFS Equities    Class R3      44.59     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R3      6.31     —     
      Class R4      16.63  
   ING    Class R4      28.31     —     
      Class R5      12.08  
   John Hancock Life Insurance Company, Buffalo, NY    Class R4      22.85     —     
   NFS LLC FEBO, Chicago, IL    Class R5      12.73     —     
   PIMS/Prudential Retirement, Greenville, SC    Class R5      9.64     —     
   Standard Insurance Company, Portland, OR    Class R5      17.20     —     

Columbia Strategic Allocation

   Columbia Management    Class I      100.00     —     
      Class R      100.00  
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Charles Schwab    Class A      7.60     —     
      Class R4      91.62  
   Fifth Third Bank TTEE FBO Speng Nath SE PS, Cincinnati, OH    Class R4      8.21     —     

 

201


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

RiverSource Balanced

   Columbia Management    Class R5      38.56     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      7.66     —     
      Class R      80.66  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class C      5.88     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO B&L Corporation    Class R      14.39     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      99.98     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class R5      57.76     —     

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      6.90  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Charles Schwab    Class A      41.85     —     
      Class R4      93.10  

Seligman California Municipal High-Yield

   Citigroup Global Markets    Class A      5.60     —     
      Class C      11.36  
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      6.44     —     
      Class C      16.88  
   Morgan Stanley & Co. (Morgan Stanley), Jersey City, NJ    Class A      5.86     —     
      Class C      14.95  
   Christopher Ranch LLC, Gilroy, CA    Class C      10.00     —     

Seligman California Municipal Quality

   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      5.64     —     
      Class C      74.10  
   Morgan Stanley    Class A      10.89     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      8.05     —     

Seligman Minnesota Municipal

   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      12.78     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class C      7.46     —     
   UBS Financial Services Inc. FBO Ethelyn C. Engel, Cold Spring, MN    Class C      6.14     —     

Seligman National Municipal

   Citigroup Global Markets    Class A      6.91     —     
      Class C      11.91  
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      8.50     —     
      Class C      17.89  
   Morgan Stanley    Class C      6.73     —     

Seligman New York Municipal

   Citigroup Global Markets    Class A      5.16     —     
      Class C      16.99  
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      8.03     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      14.31     —     

 

202


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Seligman TargETFund 2015

   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      20.65     —     
      Class C      20.29  
      Class R      41.53  
   AST Trust Company FBO Jamaica Anesthesia Assocs., Phoenix, AZ    Class A      11.05     —     
   Wilmington Trust FBO Medisys Health Network Inc., Phoenix, AZ    Class A      7.41     —     
   AST Trust Company FBO Medisys Health Network Inc., Phoenix, AZ    Class A      5.72     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Andreini Bros Inc. Empl. PS Plan    Class R      17.52     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO SGCGJ Retirement Plan    Class R      13.90     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Dearborn Mid West Co. 401K    Class R      11.61     —     
   MG Trust Company FBO Plastic Coating Corporation, Denver, CO    Class R      10.46     —     
   NFS LLC FEBO FMT CO Cust FBO Mark Stuart Shulman, Sudbury, MA    Class R5      79.44     —     
   Columbia Management    Class R5      19.68     —     

Seligman TargETFund 2025

   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      23.76     —     
      Class C      28.53  
      Class R      85.82  
   AST Trust Company FBO Medisys Health Network Inc., Phoenix, AZ    Class A      10.22     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO S.W.E.A. PC 401K    Class A      8.68     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO SGCGJ Retirement Plan    Class R      8.93     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class R5      89.81     —     

Seligman TargETFund 2035

   Columbia Management    Class R5      94.33     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      23.94     —     
      Class C      44.56  
      Class R      42.36  
   Reliance Trust Co. FBO Time Acquisition Holding 401K, Atlanta, GA    Class A      27.12     —     
   Reliance Trust Co. FBO Finn Dixon & Herling 401K Plan, Atlanta, GA    Class A      19.02     —     
   New York Life Trust Company, Parsippany, NJ    Class A      5.57     —     
   First Clearing, LLC A/C James Drake, Westville, IN    Class C      5.92     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Dearborn Mid West Co. 401K    Class R      25.67     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO SGCGJ Retirement Plan    Class R      19.90     —     

 

203


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Seligman TargETFund 2045

   Columbia Management    Class R5      44.80     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      33.51     —     
      Class C      62.30  
      Class R      78.86  
   Reliance Trust Co. FBO Time Acquisition Holding 401K, Atlanta, GA    Class A      20.62     —     
   New York Life Trust Company, Parsippany, NJ    Class A      9.87     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Wamore, Inc. 401K    Class R      9.01     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class R5      52.51     —     

Seligman TargETFund Core

   Columbia Management    Class R5      11.58     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      21.61     —     
      Class C      40.42  
      Class R      77.82  
   Fifth Third Bank TTEE FBO Bankwest Inc., Cincinnati, OH    Class A      7.27     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Dearborn Mid West Co. 401K    Class R      11.10     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services Inc.    Class R5      87.88     —     

Funds with fiscal period ending October 31

       

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income

   Columbia Management    Class R4      100.00     —     
      Class R5      100.00  
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Conservative Fund    Class I      7.69     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderate Fund    Class I      7.28     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderately Conservative Fund    Class I      7.76     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      16.00     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      43.91     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      11.65     —     
   American Enterprise    Class W      99.91     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      60.74     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.32     —     

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond

   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderate Fund    Class I      5.28     40.87 %(a) 
   Columbia Income Builder Fund    Class I      11.78     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund II    Class I      42.49     —     
   Columbia Income Builder Fund III    Class I      23.71  
   Columbia Management    Class R4      44.59     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.    Class W      99.97     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      38.45     —     
      Class R4      27.29  
   Matrix Capital    Class R4      28.12     —     
   Morgan Stanley    Class A      12.85     —     
   First Clearing, LLC, Rochester, NY    Class C      7.58     —     
   Morgan Stanley    Class C      7.30     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.    Class C      6.12     —     

 

204


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.43     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.71     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      30.55     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.51     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.78     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      13.50     —     
      Class R4      100.00  
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      39.64     —     
      Class R      88.30  
   Columbia Management    Class R4      100.00     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      87.00     —     

Columbia European Equity

   Columbia Management    Class I      100.00     —     
      Class R4      16.14     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      9.89     —     
   Marilyn O. Matthews, Pasadena, CA    Class C      5.48     —     
  

MG Trust Company Cust. FBO

Urologic Surgery, P.C.

401K, Denver, CO

   Class R4      79.53     —     

Columbia Frontier

   Columbia Management    Class R      9.37     —     
      Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R4      51.23     —     
   Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      99.50     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class R4      48.77     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      9.02     —     
      Class C      21.88  
      Class R      63.03  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class B      7.06     —     
   State Street Bank and Trust as Custodian, Miami, FL    Class B      5.48     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO    Class R      14.43     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Financial Network Audit, LLC    Class R      6.59     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO C. Anthony Phillps Accountancy 401    Class R      6.18     —     
   Gramma Fisher Foundation (Gramma Fisher Foundation), Easton, MD    Class R5      67.75     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      29.23     —     

 

205


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Global Equity

   Columbia Management    Class R      45.30     —     
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R5      27.38  
      Class W      100.00  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      13.68     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      29.50     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      35.14     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      7.43     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      11.65     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      10.22     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      7.39     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO C. Anthony Phillps Accountancy 401    Class R      18.43     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO EFK Moen 401K         11.56     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Financial Network Audit, LLC         11.09     —     
  

MG Trust Company Cust. FBO Applied

Reliability

Engineering, Denver, CO

        10.24     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      95.89     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.    Class R5      72.62     —     

Columbia Global Bond

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      7.10     32.99 %(a) 
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund    Class I      7.65     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      30.72     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      26.31     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      13.68     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.    Class W      99.95     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      12.28     —     
      Class R4      100.00  

Columbia Global Extended Alpha

   Columbia Management    Class C      6.99     58.96 %(a) 
      Class I      100.00  
      Class R      100.00  
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      12.01  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Charles Schwab    Class A      45.04     —     
      Class R4      87.99  
   American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.    Class B      61.97     —     
   William F. and Naorma M. Paden, Yuba City, CA    Class C      21.81     —     
   Ronald J. Oberdick, Morristown, NJ    Class C      18.56     —     
   Pershing LLC, Jersey City, NJ    Class C      15.60     —     
   Michael Selig, Arlington, VA    Class C      10.77     —     
   Poonam and Pradeep Singh, McLean, VA    Class C      10.15     —     
   Jennifer S. Carter, Washington, D.C.    Class C      8.29     —     
   Jon Paul and Rachel Colquitt, Clifton, VA    Class C      7.83     —     

 

206


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value

   Charles Schwab    Class A      12.19     —     
      Class R4      98.90  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      17.99     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.11     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.76     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.30     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.41     —     

Columbia Seligman Global Technology

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R5      100.00  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.03     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.13     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.99     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.24     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.44     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class R4      93.18     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      8.81     —     
      Class B      10.15  
      Class C      20.21  
      Class R      12.22  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class C      5.27     —     
   Hartford Life Insurance Co., Hartford, CT    Class R      73.45     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Dearborn Mid West Conveyor    Class R      7.17     —     

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     28.08 %(a) 
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      8.28  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderate Fund    Class I      11.85     —     
   Disciplined Asset Allocation Moderately Aggressive Fund    Class I      7.92     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      8.11     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      11.33     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      13.48     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      8.31     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services, Inc.    Class W      99.98     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      10.66     —     
      Class R4      91.72  
   Daniel and Linda Miklovic, St. Louis, MO    Class C      6.39     —     

 

207


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth

   Charles Schwab    Class A      10.95     47.03 %(a) 
      Class R4      82.52  
   New York Life Trust Company    Class R4      16.27     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      17.97     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.12     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.80     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.29     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.39     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.08     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO U.S. Tank Alliance, Inc.    Class R      38.15     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO B&L Corporation 401K    Class R      18.63     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Financial Audit, LLC 401K    Class R      13.69     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO C. Anthony Phillips Accountants    Class R      8.86     —     
   MG Trust Company FBO Claudina A. Bonilla MD FCCP PA, Denver, CO    Class R      5.90     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      97.22     —     

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap

   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      17.83     50.85 %(a) 
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.47     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      30.16     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.33     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      17.77     —     
   Charles Schwab    Class A      9.01     —     
      Class R4      11.78  
   Morgan Stanley    Class C      14.62     —     
   Taynik & Co., Boston, MA    Class R4      48.66     —     
   Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Co., Springfield, MA    Class R4      36.89     —     

Threadneedle Global Equity Income

   Columbia Management    Class I      100.00     —     
      Class R      100.00  
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      81.26  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Charles Schwab    Class A      16.66     —     
      Class R4      18.74  
   Michael A. And Mary N. Brockman, Fort Madison, IA    Class C      10.63     —     
   David L. and Diane M Cooper, Prescott, AZ    Class C      9.56     —     
   Janet K. Zimmer, Warsaw, IN    Class C      7.05     —     

 

208


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Threadneedle International Opportunity

   Columbia Management    Class R      100.00     28.96 %(a) 
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R5      100.00  
   Charles Schwab    Class A      7.77     —     
      Class R4      80.39  
   Matrix Capital    Class R4      19.61     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      18.02     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      25.06     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      29.80     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.27     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      18.42     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Ed’s Supply Co.    Class R      20.34     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Sales West Partners Inc. 401K    Class R      12.03     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Horne Bros. Construction 401K    Class R      11.09     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Kingchem, Inc. 401K    Class R      10.59     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Natural Habitat Adventures    Class R      9.91     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Tofel Employee 401K    Class R      9.72     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Woburn Daily Times, Inc. 401K    Class R      9.04     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Tremont Electric 401K    Class R      8.06     —     

Funds with fiscal period ending November 30

    

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond

   None    N/A      N/A        —     

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity

   Charles Schwab    Class A      7.03     —     
      Class R4      9.07  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund    Class I      16.45     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund    Class I      27.43     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund    Class I      31.54     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund    Class I      6.84     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund    Class I      15.38     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      6.87     —     
   Morgan Stanley    Class C      5.20     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      82.55     —     
   US Bank NA, Milwaukee, WI    Class R4      8.20     —     

RiverSource Intermediate Tax Exempt

   Charles Schwab    Class A      8.06     —     
   First Clearing LLC, A/C T. J. Househmandzadeh, Cerritos, CA    Class C      5.36     —     

 

209


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income

   None    N/A      N/A        —     

Funds with fiscal period ending December 31

    

Columbia Government Money Market

   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      96.68     —     

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R4      100.00  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      18.01     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate    Class I      25.60     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    Class I      29.73     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative    Class I      6.32     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      18.21     —     
   Morgan Stanley    Class A      52.66     —     
   New York Life Trust Company, Parsippany, NJ    Class A      7.89     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class B      9.78     —     
      Class C      30.39  
      Class R      79.31  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class B      5.54     —     
      Class C      5.05     —     
   Gramma Fisher Foundation    Class R5      48.68     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R5      41.42     —     

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R4      10.70  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      25.11     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      74.75     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      32.91     —     
      Class R      76.90  
   Charles Schwab    Class R4      89.30     —     
   Gramma Fisher Foundation    Class R5      51.12     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      35.29     —     

 

210


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares     Percent of  Fund
(if greater than 25%)
 

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage    

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information

   Columbia Management    Class R3      35.45     —     
      Class R4      43.28  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      17.94     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate    Class I      25.55     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    Class I      29.87     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative    Class I      6.28     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      18.24     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      11.16     —     
      Class B      18.43  
      Class C      21.58  
      Class R      39.63  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class A      5.15     —     
      Class B      7.46  
      Class C      6.95  
   Charles Schwab    Class A      6.57     —     
      Class R4      56.72  
   Morgan Stanley    Class B      5.30     —     
   Hartford Life Insurance Co., Hartford, CT    Class R      30.01     —     
   JPMorgan Chase Bank , New York, NY    Class R      7.48     —     
   Pershing LLC, Jersey City, NJ    Class R3      64.41     —     

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate

   Columbia Management    Class A      18.00     46.18 %(a) 
      Class R      5.78  
      Class R3      100.00  
      Class R4      85.27  
   Morgan Stanley    Class A      17.26     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      15.79     —     
      Class C      51.01  
      Class R      85.35  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      42.79     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      57.11     —     
   Frontier Trust Company FBO Valley Ford 401K, Fargo, ND    Class R      8.87     —     
   Scottrade Inc. FBO Jeffrey Powers IRA, Saint Louis, MO    Class R4      14.73     —     
   Gramma Fisher Foundation    Class R5      61.69     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      37.91     —     

 

211


Table of Contents

 

          Fund Shares        

Fund

  

Shareholder name, city and state

   Share Class    Percentage     Percent of Fund
(if  greater than 25%)
 

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R4      38.39  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    Class I      99.62     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class A      13.25     —     
      Class B      22.58  
      Class C      50.85  
      Class R      87.25  
   Citigroup Global Markets    Class B      6.12     —     
      Class C      7.74  
   Scottrade Inc. FBO Kenny K. Fong, Saint Louis, MO    Class R4      61.61     —     
   Gramma Fisher Foundation    Class R5      61.08     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      36.74     —     

Seligman Capital

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
      Class R4      100.00  
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      36.94     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    Class I      7.86     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      55.15     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class B      10.68     —     
      Class C      26.29  
      Class R      71.60  
   Gramma Fisher Foundation    Class R5      56.11     —     
   Patricks Plain LLC    Class R5      40.66     —     

Seligman Growth

   Columbia Management    Class R3      100.00     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive    Class I      17.97     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate    Class I      25.53     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive    Class I      29.84     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative    Class I      6.31     —     
   Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity    Class I      18.21     —     
   Ameriprise Trust Company    Class R4      91.71     —     
   Wachovia Bank    Class R4      7.61     —     
   MLP Fenner & Smith    Class C      9.80     —     
   Frontier Trust Company, Fargo, ND    Class R      70.27     —     
   MG Trust Company FBO Global Surveillance Associates, Denver, CO    Class R      6.60     —     
   Gramma Fisher Foundation    Class R5      85.93     —     
   American Enterprise Investment Services    Class R5      8.30     —     

 

(a) Combination of all share classes of Columbia Management initial capital and affiliated funds-of-funds’ investments in Class I shares.

A fund may serve as an underlying investment of funds-of-funds that principally invest in shares of affiliated funds in the Fund Family (the underlying funds). The underlying funds and the funds-of-funds share the same officers, Board members, and investment manager. The funds-of-funds do not invest in an underlying fund for the purpose of exercising management or control; however, from time to time, investments by the funds-of-funds in a fund may represent a significant portion of a fund. Because the funds-of-funds may own a substantial portion of the shares of a fund, procedures have been put into place to assure that public shareholders will determine the outcome of all actions taken at underlying fund shareholder meetings. In proxy voting, the funds-of-funds will vote on each proposal in the same proportion that other shareholders vote on the proposal.

In addition, Columbia Management or an affiliate may own shares of a fund as a result of an initial capital investment at the inception of the fund or class. To the extent Columbia Management, as manager of the funds-of-funds, may be deemed a

 

212


Table of Contents

beneficial owner of the shares of an underlying fund held by the funds-of-funds, and such shares, together with any initial capital investment by Columbia Management or an affiliate, represent more than 25% of a fund, Columbia Management and its affiliated companies may be deemed to control the fund.

Information Regarding Pending and Settled Legal Proceedings

In June 2004, an action captioned John E. Gallus et al. v. American Express Financial Corp. and American Express Financial Advisors Inc., was filed in the United States District Court for the District of Arizona. The plaintiffs allege that they are investors in several American Express Company (now known as legacy RiverSource) mutual funds and they purport to bring the action derivatively on behalf of those funds under the 1940 Act. The plaintiffs allege that fees allegedly paid to the defendants by the funds for investment advisory and administrative services are excessive. The plaintiffs seek remedies including restitution and rescission of investment advisory and distribution agreements. The plaintiffs voluntarily agreed to transfer this case to the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota (the “District Court”). In response to defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint, the District Court dismissed one of plaintiffs’ four claims and granted plaintiffs limited discovery. Defendants moved for summary judgment in April 2007. Summary judgment was granted in the defendants’ favor on July 9, 2007. The plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal with the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals (the “Eighth Circuit”) on Aug. 8, 2007. On April 8, 2009, the Eighth Circuit reversed summary judgment and remanded to the District Court for further proceedings. On August 6, 2009, defendants filed a writ of certiorari with the U.S. Supreme Court (the “Supreme Court”), asking the Supreme Court to stay the District Court proceedings while the Supreme Court considers and rules in a case captioned Jones v. Harris Associates, which involves issues of law similar to those presented in the Gallus case. On March 30, 2010, the Supreme Court issued its ruling in Jones v. Harris Associates, and on April 5, 2010, the Supreme Court vacated the Eighth Circuit’s decision in the Gallus case and remanded the case to the Eighth Circuit for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates. On June 4, 2010, the Eighth Circuit remanded the Gallus case to the District Court for further consideration in light of the Supreme Court’s decision in Jones v. Harris Associates.

In December 2005, without admitting or denying the allegations, American Express Financial Corporation (AEFC, which is now known as Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (Ameriprise Financial)), entered into settlement agreements with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and Minnesota Department of Commerce (MDOC) related to market timing activities. As a result, AEFC was censured and ordered to cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of certain provisions of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, the Investment Company Act of 1940, and various Minnesota laws. AEFC agreed to pay disgorgement of $10 million and civil money penalties of $7 million. AEFC also agreed to retain an independent distribution consultant to assist in developing a plan for distribution of all disgorgement and civil penalties ordered by the SEC in accordance with various undertakings detailed at http://www.sec.gov/litigation/admin/ia-2451.pdf. Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates have cooperated with the SEC and the MDOC in these legal proceedings, and have made regular reports to the funds’ Boards of Directors/Trustees.

Ameriprise Financial and certain of its affiliates have historically been involved in a number of legal, arbitration and regulatory proceedings, including routine litigation, class actions, and governmental actions, concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of their business activities. Ameriprise Financial believes that the Funds are not currently the subject of, and that neither Ameriprise Financial nor any of its affiliates are the subject of, any pending legal, arbitration or regulatory proceedings that are likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds. Ameriprise Financial is required to make 10-Q, 10-K and, as necessary, 8-K filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission on legal and regulatory matters that relate to Ameriprise Financial and its affiliates. Copies of these filings may be obtained by accessing the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

There can be no assurance that these matters, or the adverse publicity associated with them, will not result in increased fund redemptions, reduced sale of fund shares or other adverse consequences to the Funds. Further, although we believe proceedings are not likely to have a material adverse effect on the Funds or the ability of Ameriprise Financial or its affiliates to perform under their contracts with the Funds, these proceedings are subject to uncertainties and, as such, we are unable to estimate the possible loss or range of loss that may result. An adverse outcome in one or more of these proceedings could result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties or other relief that could have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations of Ameriprise Financial.

 

213


Table of Contents

 

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

For RiverSource and Threadneedle funds, the financial statements for the fiscal years ended on or after July 31, 2007, and for Seligman funds, the financial statements for the fiscal years ended on or after Sept. 30, 2009 contained in a fund’s Annual Report were audited by the independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young LLP, 220 South 6th Street, Suite 1400, Minneapolis, MN 55402. The independent registered public accounting firm also provides other accounting and tax-related services as requested by the funds. For RiverSource funds, the financial statements for periods ended on or before June 30, 2007 were audited by other auditors. For Seligman funds, the financial statements for periods ended on or before Dec. 31, 2008 were audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP.

 

214


Table of Contents

 

Appendix A

DESCRIPTION OF RATINGS

Standard & Poor’s Long-Term Debt Ratings.

A Standard & Poor’s corporate or municipal debt rating is a current assessment of the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to a specific obligation. This assessment may take into consideration obligors such as guarantors, insurers, or lessees.

The debt rating is not a recommendation to purchase, sell, or hold a security, inasmuch as it does not comment as to market price or suitability for a particular investor.

The ratings are based on current information furnished by the issuer or obtained by S&P from other sources it considers reliable. S&P does not perform an audit in connection with any rating and may, on occasion, rely on unaudited financial information. The ratings may be changed, suspended, or withdrawn as a result of changes in, or unavailability of such information or based on other circumstances.

The ratings are based, in varying degrees, on the following considerations:

 

   

Likelihood of default capacity and willingness of the obligor as to the timely payment of interest and repayment of principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation.

 

   

Nature of and provisions of the obligation.

 

   

Protection afforded by, and relative position of, the obligation in the event of bankruptcy, reorganization, or other arrangement under the laws of bankruptcy and other laws affecting creditors’ rights.

Investment Grade

Debt rated AAA has the highest rating assigned by Standard & Poor’s. Capacity to pay interest and repay principal is extremely strong.

Debt rated AA has a very strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal and differs from the highest rated issues only in a small degree.

Debt rated A has a strong capacity to pay interest and repay principal, although it is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher-rated categories.

Debt rated BBB is regarded as having an adequate capacity to pay interest and repay principal. Whereas it normally exhibits adequate protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity to pay interest and repay principal for debt in this category than in higher-rated categories.

Speculative Grade

Debt rated BB, B, CCC, CC, and C is regarded as having predominantly speculative characteristics with respect to capacity to pay interest and repay principal. BB indicates the least degree of speculation and C the highest. While such debt will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or major exposures to adverse conditions.

Debt rated BB has less near-term vulnerability to default than other speculative issues. However, it faces major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions that could lead to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments. The BB rating category also is used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BBB- rating.

Debt rated B has a greater vulnerability to default but currently has the capacity to meet interest payments and principal repayments. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to pay interest and repay principal. The B rating category also is used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied BB or BB- rating.

Debt rated CCC has a currently identifiable vulnerability to default and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions to meet timely payment of interest and repayment of principal. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, it is not likely to have the capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The CCC rating category also is used for debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied B or B- rating.

Debt rated CC typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC rating.

Debt rated C typically is applied to debt subordinated to senior debt that is assigned an actual or implied CCC rating. The C rating may be used to cover a situation where a bankruptcy petition has been filed, but debt service payments are continued.

The rating CI is reserved for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

 

Debt rated D is in payment default. The D rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments are not made on the date due, even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made during such grace period. The D rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.

Moody’s Long-Term Debt Ratings

Aaa – Bonds that are rated Aaa are judged to be of the best quality. They carry the smallest degree of investment risk. Interest payments are protected by a large or by an exceptionally stable margin and principal is secure. While the various protective elements are likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair the fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Aa – Bonds that are rated Aa are judged to be of high quality by all standards. Together with the Aaa group they comprise what are generally known as high grade bonds. They are rated lower than the best bonds because margins of protection may not be as large as in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective elements may be of greater amplitude or there may be other elements present that make the long-term risk appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

A – Bonds that are rated A possess many favorable investment attributes and are to be considered as upper-medium grade obligations. Factors giving security to principal and interest are considered adequate, but elements may be present that suggest a susceptibility to impairment some time in the future.

Baa – Bonds that are rated Baa are considered as medium-grade obligations (i.e., they are neither highly protected nor poorly secured). Interest payments and principal security appear adequate for the present but certain protective elements may be lacking or may be characteristically unreliable over any great length of time. Such bonds lack outstanding investment characteristics and in fact have speculative characteristics as well.

Ba – Bonds that are rated Ba are judged to have speculative elements – their future cannot be considered as well- assured. Often the protection of interest and principal payments may be very moderate, and thereby not well safeguarded during both good and bad times over the future. Uncertainty of position characterizes bonds in this class.

B – Bonds that are rated B generally lack characteristics of a desirable investment. Assurance of interest and principal payments or maintenance of other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Caa – Bonds that are rated Caa are of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Ca – Bonds that are rated Ca represent obligations that are speculative in a high degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

C – Bonds that are rated C are the lowest rated class of bonds, and issues so rated can be regarded as having extremely poor prospects of ever attaining any real investment standing.

Fitch’s Long-Term Debt Ratings

Fitch’s bond ratings provide a guide to investors in determining the credit risk associated with a particular security. The ratings represent Fitch’s assessment of the issuer’s ability to meet the obligations of a specific debt issue in a timely manner.

The rating takes into consideration special features of the issue, its relationship to other obligations of the issuer, the current and prospective financial condition and operating performance of the issuer and any guarantor, as well as the economic and political environment that might affect the issuer’s future financial strength and credit quality.

Fitch ratings do not reflect any credit enhancement that may be provided by insurance policies or financial guaranties unless otherwise indicated.

Fitch ratings are not recommendations to buy, sell or hold any security. Ratings do not comment on the adequacy of market price, the suitability of any security for a particular investor, or the tax-exempt nature of taxability of payments made in respect of any security.

Fitch ratings are based on information obtained from issuers, other obligors, underwriters, their experts, and other sources Fitch believes to be reliable. Fitch does not audit or verify the truth or accuracy of such information. Ratings may be changed, suspended, or withdrawn as a result of changes in, or the unavailability of, information or for other reasons.

Investment Grade

AAA: Bonds considered to be investment grade and of the highest credit quality. The obligor has an exceptionally strong ability to pay interest and repay principal, which is unlikely to be affected by reasonably foreseeable events.

 

A-2


Table of Contents

 

AA: Bonds considered to be investment grade and of very high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is very strong, although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA. Because bonds rated in the AAA and AA categories are not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable future developments, short-term debt of these issuers is generally rated F-1+.

A: Bonds considered to be investment grade and of high credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered to be strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances than bonds with higher ratings.

BBB: Bonds considered to be investment grade and of satisfactory credit quality. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered to be adequate. Adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances, however, are more likely to have adverse impact on these bonds and, therefore, impair timely payment. The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall below investment grade is higher than for bonds with higher ratings.

Speculative Grade

BB: Bonds are considered speculative. The obligor’s ability to pay interest and repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes. However, business and financial alternatives can be identified, which could assist the obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B: Bonds are considered highly speculative. While bonds in this class are currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely payment of principal and interest reflects the obligor’s limited margin of safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the life of the issue.

CCC: Bonds have certain identifiable characteristics that, if not remedied, may lead to default. The ability to meet obligations requires an advantageous business and economic environment.

CC: Bonds are minimally protected. Default in payment of interest and/or principal seems probable over time.

C: Bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D: Bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments. Such bonds are extremely speculative and should be valued on the basis of their ultimate recovery value in liquidation or reorganization of the obligor. DDD represents the highest potential for recovery on these bonds, and D represents the lowest potential for recovery.

SHORT-TERM RATINGS

Standard & Poor’s Commercial Paper Ratings

A Standard & Poor’s commercial paper rating is a current assessment of the likelihood of timely payment of debt considered short-term in the relevant market.

Ratings are graded into several categories, ranging from A-1 for the highest quality obligations to D for the lowest. These categories are as follows:

 

A-1 This highest category indicates that the degree of safety regarding timely payment is strong. Those issues determined to possess extremely strong safety characteristics are denoted with a plus sign (+) designation.

 

A-2 Capacity for timely payment on issues with this designation is satisfactory. However, the relative degree of safety is not as high as for issues designated A-1.

 

A-3 Issues carrying this designation have adequate capacity for timely payment. They are, however, more vulnerable to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances than obligations carrying the higher designations.

 

B Issues are regarded as having only speculative capacity for timely payment.

 

C This rating is assigned to short-term debt obligations with doubtful capacity for payment.

 

D Debt rated D is in payment default. The D rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments are not made on the date due, even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made during such grace period.

Standard & Poor’s Muni Bond and Note Ratings

An S&P municipal bond or note rating reflects the liquidity factors and market-access risks unique to these instruments. Notes maturing in three years or less will likely receive a note rating. Notes maturing beyond three years will most likely receive a long-term debt rating.

 

A-3


Table of Contents

 

Note rating symbols and definitions are as follows:

 

SP-1 Strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Issues determined to possess very strong characteristics are given a plus (+) designation.

 

SP-2 Satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest, with some vulnerability to adverse financial and economic changes over the term of the notes.

 

SP-3 Speculative capacity to pay principal and interest.

Municipal bond rating symbols and definitions are as follows:

Standard & Poor’s rating SP-1 indicates very strong or strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Those issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics will be given a plus (+) designation.

Standard & Poor’s rating SP-2 indicates satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest.

Standard & Poor’s rating SP-3 indicates speculative capacity to pay principal and interest.

Moody’s Short-Term Ratings

Moody’s short-term debt ratings are opinions of the ability of issuers to repay punctually senior debt obligations. These obligations have an original maturity not exceeding one year, unless explicitly noted.

Moody’s employs the following three designations, all judged to be investment grade, to indicate the relative repayment ability of rated issuers:

Issuers rated Prime-1 (or supporting institutions) have a superior ability for repayment of senior short-term debt obligations. Prime-1 repayment ability will often be evidenced by many of the following characteristics: (i) leading market positions in well-established industries, (ii) high rates of return on funds employed, (iii) conservative capitalization structure with moderate reliance on debt and ample asset protection, (iv) broad margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges and high internal cash generation, and (v) well established access to a range of financial markets and assured sources of alternate liquidity.

Issuers rated Prime-2 (or supporting institutions) have a strong ability for repayment of senior short-term debt obligations. This will normally be evidenced by many of the characteristics cited above, but to a lesser degree. Earnings trends and coverage ratios, while sound, may be more subject to variation. Capitalization characteristics, while still appropriate, may be more affected by external conditions. Ample alternate liquidity is maintained.

Issuers rated Prime-3 (or supporting institutions) have an acceptable ability for repayment of senior short-term obligations. The effect of industry characteristics and market compositions may be more pronounced. Variability in earnings and profitability may result in changes in the level of debt protection measurements and may require relatively high financial leverage. Adequate alternate liquidity is maintained.

Issuers rated Not Prime do not fall within any of the Prime rating categories.

Moody’s Short-Term Muni Bonds and Notes

Short-term municipal bonds and notes are rated by Moody’s. The ratings reflect the liquidity concerns and market access risks unique to notes.

Moody’s MIG 1/VMIG 1 indicates the best quality. There is present strong protection by established cash flows, superior liquidity support or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.

Moody’s MIG 2/VMIG 2 indicates high quality. Margins of protection are ample although not so large as in the preceding group.

Moody’s MIG 3/VMIG 3 indicates favorable quality. All security elements are accounted for but there is lacking the undeniable strength of the preceding grades. Liquidity and cash flow protection may be narrow and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.

Moody’s MIG 4/VMIG 4 indicates adequate quality. Protection commonly regarded as required of an investment security is present and although not distinctly or predominantly speculative, there is specific risk.

Fitch’s Short-Term Ratings

Fitch’s short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand or have original maturities of generally up to three years, including commercial paper, certificates of deposit, medium-term notes, and municipal and investment notes. The

 

A-4


Table of Contents

short-term rating places greater emphasis than a long-term rating on the existence of liquidity necessary to meet the issuer’s obligations in a timely manner.

Fitch short-term ratings are as follows:

F-1+: Exceptionally Strong Credit Quality. Issues assigned this rating are regarded as having the strongest degree of assurance for timely payment.

F-1: Very Strong Credit Quality. Issues assigned this rating reflect an assurance of timely payment only slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2: Good Credit Quality. Issues assigned this rating have a satisfactory degree of assurance for timely payment, but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned F-1+ and F-1 ratings.

F-3: Fair Credit Quality. Issues assigned this rating have characteristics suggesting that the degree of assurance for timely payment is adequate, however, near-term adverse changes could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S: Weak Credit Quality. Issues assigned this rating have characteristics suggesting a minimal degree of assurance for timely payment and are vulnerable to near-term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions.

D: Default. Issues assigned this rating are in actual or imminent payment default.

 

A-5


Table of Contents

 

Appendix B

STATE TAX-EXEMPT FUNDS

STATE RISK FACTORS

The State Tax-Exempt Funds invest primarily in the municipal securities issued by a single state and political sub-divisions that state. Each Fund will be particularly affected by political and economic conditions and developments in the state in which it invests. This vulnerability to factors affecting the state’s tax- exempt investments will be significantly greater than that of more geographically diversified funds, which may result in greater losses and volatility. Because of the relatively small number of issuers of tax-exempt securities, the Fund may invest a higher percentage of assets in a single issuer and, therefore, be more exposed to the risk of loss by investing in a few issuers than a fund that invests more broadly. At times, the Fund and other accounts managed by the investment manager may own all or most of the debt of a particular issuer. This concentration of ownership may make it more difficult to sell, or to determine the fair value of, these investments. In addition, a Fund may concentrate in a segment of the tax-exempt debt market, such as revenue bonds for health care facilities, housing or airports. These investments may cause the value of a fund’s shares to change more than the values of funds’ shares that invest in more diversified investments. The yields on the securities in which the Fund invests generally are dependent on a variety of factors, including the financial condition of the issuer or other obligor, the revenue source from which the debt service is payable, general economic and monetary conditions, conditions in the relevant market, the size of a particular issue, the maturity of the obligation, and the rating of the issue. In addition to such factors, geographically concentrated securities will experience particular sensitivity to local conditions, including political and economic changes, adverse conditions to an industry significant to the area, and other developments within a particular locality. Because many tax-exempt bonds may be revenue or general obligations of local governments or authorities, ratings on tax-exempt bonds may be different from the ratings given to the general obligation bonds of a particular state.

Certain events may adversely affect all investments within a particular market segment of the market. Examples include litigation, legislation or court decisions, concerns about pending or contemplated litigation, legislation or court decisions, or lower demand for the services or products provided by a particular market segment. Investing mostly in state-specific tax-exempt investments makes the Fund more vulnerable to that state’s economy and to factors affecting tax-exempt issuers in that state than would be true for more geographically diversified funds. These risks include, among others:

 

   

the inability or perceived inability of a government authority to collect sufficient tax or other revenues to meet its payment obligations;

 

   

natural disasters and ecological or environmental concerns;

 

   

the introduction of constitutional or statutory limits on a tax-exempt issuer’s ability to raise revenues or increase taxes;

 

   

the inability of an issuer to pay interest on or repay principal or securities in which the funds invest during recessionary periods; and

 

   

economic or demographic factors that may cause a decrease in tax or other revenues for a government authority or for private operators of publicly financed facilities.

More information about state specific risks may be available from official state resources.

 

B-1


Table of Contents

 

Appendix C

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ABOUT THE S&P 500 INDEX

The fund is not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by S&P. S&P makes no representation or warranty, express or implied, to the shareholders of the Fund or any member of the public regarding the advisability of investing in securities generally or in the Fund particularly or the ability of the S&P 500 Index to track general stock market performance. S&P’s only relationship to the Fund is the licensing of certain trademarks and trade names of S&P and of the S&P 500 Index, which are determined, composed and calculated by S&P without regard to the Fund. S&P has no obligation to take the needs of the Fund or its shareholders into consideration in determining, composing or calculating the S&P 500 Index. S&P is not responsible for and has not participated in the determination of the prices and amount of the Fund or the timing of the issuance or sale of the Fund or in the determination or calculation of the equation by which the Fund’s shares are to be converted into cash. S&P has no obligation or liability in connection with the administration, marketing or trading of Fund shares.

S&P DOES NOT GUARANTEE THE ACCURACY AND/OR THE COMPLETENESS OF THE S&P 500 INDEX OR ANY DATA INCLUDED THEREIN (THE S&P INDEX) AND S&P SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITY FOR ANY ERRORS, OMISSIONS OR INTERRUPTIONS THEREIN. S&P MAKES NO WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, AS TO RESULTS TO BE OBTAINED BY THE FUND, ITS SHAREHOLDERS OR ANY OTHER PERSON OR ENTITY FROM THE USE OF THE S&P INDEX OR ANY DATA INCLUDED THEREIN. S&P MAKES NO EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, AND EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR USE WITH RESPECT TO THE S&P INDEX OR ANY DATA INCLUDED THEREIN. WITHOUT LIMITING ANY OF THE FOREGOING, IN NO EVENT SHALL S&P HAVE ANY LIABILITY FOR ANY SPECIAL, PUNITIVE, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING LOST PROFITS), EVEN IF NOTIFIED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.

 

C-1


Table of Contents

 

Appendix D

Class A – Calculation of the Sales Charge

Sales charges are determined as shown in the following table. The table is organized by investment category. You can find your fund’s investment category in Table 1.

Table 9. Class A Initial Sales Charge

 

           Sales charge(a) as  a percentage of:  

Fund category

   Total market value    Public  offering
price(b)
    Net amount
invested
 

Balanced, Equity, Fund-of-funds – equity*

   $0 – $49,999      5.75     6.10
   $50,000 – $99,999      4.50     4.71
   $100,000 – $249,999      3.50     3.63
   $250,000 – $499,999      2.50     2.56
   $500,000 – $999,999      2.00     2.04
   $1,000,000 or  more(c),(d)      0.00     0.00

Fund-of-funds – fixed income, State tax-exempt fixed income, Taxable fixed income, Tax-exempt fixed income

   $0 – $49,999      4.75     4.99
   $50,000 – $99,999      4.25     4.44
   $100,000 – $249,999      3.50     3.63
   $250,000 – $499,999      2.50     2.56
   $500,000 – $999,999      2.00     2.04
   $1,000,000 or  more(c),(d)      0.00     0.00

For Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund, Columbia Floating Rate Fund, Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund, Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund, RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund and RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

   $0 – $99,999      3.00     3.09
   $100,000 – $249,999      2.50     2.56
   $250,000 – $499,999      2.00     2.04
   $500,000 – $999,999      1.50     1.52
   $1,000,000 or  more(c),(d)      0.00     0.00

 

* RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund is not subject to a front-end sales change on Class A shares.
(a) Because the offering price is calculated to two decimal places, the dollar amount of the sales charge as a percentage of the offering price and your net amount invested for any particular purchase of fund shares may be higher or lower depending on whether downward or upward rounding was required during the calculation process.
(b) Purchase price includes the sales charge.
(c) Although there is no sales charge for purchases with a total market value of $1 million or more, and therefore no re-allowance, the distributor may pay a selling and/or servicing agent the following out of its own resources: 1.00% on purchases from $1 million up to but not including $3 million; 0.50% on purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and 0.25% on amounts of $50 million or more. The distributor may be reimbursed if a CDSC is deducted when the shares are redeemed.
(d) For eligible employee benefit plans, selling and/or servicing agents are eligible to receive from the distributor the following sales commissions on purchases that are coded as commission eligible trades: 1.00% on all purchases up to but not including $3 million, including those in amounts of less than $1 million; up to 0.50% on all purchases of $3 million up to but not including $50 million; and up to 0.25% on all purchases of $50 million or more.

 

D-1


Table of Contents

 

Appendix E

Legacy Columbia Funds

Legacy Columbia funds are funds that were branded Columbia or Columbia Acorn prior to Sept. 27, 2010.

 

Columbiasm Acorn® Fund

Columbiasm Acorn International®

Columbiasm Acorn International Select®

Columbiasm Acorn Select®

Columbiasm Acorn USA®

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund

Columbia Asset Allocation Fund II

Columbia Balanced Fund

Columbia Blended Equity Fund

Columbia Bond Fund

Columbia California Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia California Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Connecticut Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Connecticut Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Conservative High Yield Fund

Columbia Contrarian Core Fund

Columbia Convertible Securities Fund

Columbia Core Bond Fund

Columbia Corporate Income Fund (formerly known as

Columbia Income Fund)

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund

Columbia Dividend Income Fund

Columbia Emerging Markets Fund

Columbia Energy and Natural Resources Fund

Columbia Federal Securities Fund

Columbia Georgia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Global Value Fund

Columbia Greater China Fund

Columbia High Income Fund

Columbia High Yield Municipal Fund

Columbia High Yield Opportunity Fund

Columbia Intermediate Bond Fund

Columbia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia International Bond Fund

Columbia International Growth Fund

Columbia International Stock Fund

Columbia International Value Fund

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund

Columbia Large Cap Enhanced Core Fund

Columbia Large Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Large Cap Index Fund

Columbia Large Cap Value Fund

Columbia Liberty Fund

Columbia LifeGoal® Balanced Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Income and Growth Portfolio

Columbia LifeGoal® Income Portfolio

Columbia Marsico 21st Century Fund

Columbia Marsico Focused Equities Fund

Columbia Marsico Global Fund

Columbia Marsico Growth Fund

Columbia Marsico International Opportunities Fund

Columbia Maryland Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Massachusetts Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Massachusetts Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Masters International Equity Portfolio

Columbia Mid Cap Core Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Index Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Value Fund

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Equity Fund

Columbia New Jersey Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia New York Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia New York Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia North Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Oregon Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Overseas Value Fund

Columbia Pacific/Asia Fund

Columbia Real Estate Equity Fund

Columbia Rhode Island Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Select Large Cap Growth Fund

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund

Columbia Select Small Cap Fund

Columbia Short Term Bond Fund

Columbia Short Term Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Short-Intermediate Bond Fund

Columbia Small Cap Core Fund

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II

Columbia Small Cap Index Fund

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund I

Columbia Small Cap Value Fund II

Columbia South Carolina Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia Strategic Income Fund

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund

Columbia Tax-Exempt Fund

Columbia Technology Fund

Columbiasm Thermostat Fund®

Columbia Total Return Bond Fund

Columbia U.S. Treasury Index Fund

Columbia Value and Restructuring Fund

Columbia Virginia Intermediate Municipal Bond Fund

Columbia World Equity Fund


 

E-1


Table of Contents

 

Appendix F

Legacy RiverSource Funds

Legacy RiverSource funds include RiverSource, Seligman and Threadneedle funds, funds renamed effective Sept. 27, 2010 to bear the Columbia brand, and certain other funds. Prior fund names are noted in parenthesis.

Columbia 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource 120/20 Contrarian Equity Fund)

Columbia Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Absolute Return Currency and Income Fund)

Columbia AMT-Free Tax-Exempt Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Tax-Exempt Bond Fund)

Columbia Asia Pacific ex-Japan Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Asia Pacific Fund)

Columbia Diversified Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Bond Fund)

Columbia Diversified Equity Income Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Diversified Equity Income Fund)

Columbia Dividend Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Dividend Opportunity Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Emerging Markets Bond Fund)

Columbia Emerging Markets Opportunity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Emerging Markets Fund)

Columbia Equity Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Equity Value Fund)

Columbia European Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle European Equity Fund)

Columbia Floating Rate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Floating Rate Fund)

Columbia Frontier Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Frontier Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Global Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Global Bond Fund)

Columbia Global Equity Fund (formerly known as Threadneedle Global Equity Fund)

Columbia Global Extended Alpha Fund (RiverSource Global Extended Alpha Fund)

Columbia Government Money Market Fund, Inc. (formerly known as RiverSource Government Money Market Fund, Inc.)

Columbia High Yield Bond Fund (formerly known as RiverSource High Yield Bond Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Basic Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund II (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Moderate Income Fund)

Columbia Income Builder Fund III (formerly known as RiverSource Income Builder Enhanced Income Fund)

Columbia Income Opportunities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Income Opportunities Fund)

Columbia Inflation Protected Securities Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Inflation Protected Securities Fund)

Columbia Large Core Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Equity Fund)

Columbia Large Growth Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Disciplined Large Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Limited Duration Credit Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Limited Duration Bond Fund)

Columbia Marsico Flexible Capital Fund

Columbia Mid Cap Growth Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Growth Fund)

Columbia Mid Cap Value Opportunity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Mid Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Minnesota Tax-Exempt Fund)

Columbia Money Market Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Cash Management Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor International Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners International Select Value Fund)

Columbia Multi-Advisor Small Cap Value Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Partners Small Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Aggressive Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Conservative Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Moderate Fund)

Columbia Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Portfolio Builder Total Equity Fund)

Columbia Recovery and Infrastructure Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Recovery and Infrastructure Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2010 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2010 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2015 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2015 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2020 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2020 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2025 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2025 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2030 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2030 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2035 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2035 Fund)

Columbia Retirement Plus 2040 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2040 Fund)

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Columbia Retirement Plus 2045 Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Retirement Plus 2045 Fund)

Columbia Select Large-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Large-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Select Smaller-Cap Value Fund (formerly known as Seligman Smaller-Cap Value Fund)

Columbia Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc. (formerly known as Seligman Communications and Information Fund, Inc.)

Columbia Seligman Global Technology Fund (formerly known as Seligman Global Technology Fund)

Columbia Short-Term Cash Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Short-Term Cash Fund)

Columbia Strategic Allocation Fund (formerly known as RiverSource Strategic Allocation Fund)

Columbia U.S. Government Mortgage Fund (formerly known as RiverSource U.S. Government Mortgage Fund)

RiverSource Balanced Fund

RiverSource California Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Disciplined International Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small and Mid Cap Equity Fund

RiverSource Disciplined Small Cap Value Fund

RiverSource Intermediate Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Global Real Estate Fund

RiverSource LaSalle Monthly Dividend Real Estate Fund

RiverSource New York Tax-Exempt Fund

RiverSource Partners Fundamental Value Fund

RiverSource Partners International Select Growth Fund

RiverSource Partners International Small Cap Fund

RiverSource Precious Metals and Mining Fund

RiverSource Real Estate Fund

RiverSource S&P 500 Index Fund

RiverSource Short Duration U.S. Government Fund

RiverSource Small Company Index Fund

RiverSource Strategic Income Allocation Fund

RiverSource Tax-Exempt High Income Fund

Seligman California Municipal High Yield Series

Seligman California Municipal Quality Series

Seligman Capital Fund, Inc.

Seligman Growth Fund, Inc.

Seligman Minnesota Municipal Class

Seligman National Municipal Class

Seligman New York Municipal Class

Seligman TargETFund 2015

Seligman TargETFund 2025

Seligman TargETFund 2035

Seligman TargETFund 2045

Seligman TargETFund Core

Threadneedle Global Equity Income Fund

Threadneedle International Opportunity Fund

S-6500 CP (9/10)

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

Appendix D – Pro forma financial statements of Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund, Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I and Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund

NARRATIVE DESCRIPTION OF THE PRO FORMA EFFECTS OF THE REORGANIZATIONS

The unaudited pro forma information set forth below for the twelve month periods ended on the dates indicated is intended to present supplemental data as if the reorganizations of one or more funds (each a “Selling Fund” and together, the “Selling Funds”) into other corresponding funds (each a “Buying Fund” and together, the “Buying Funds”), as noted in Table 1 below (the “Reorganizations”), had occurred as of the beginning of the period (unless otherwise noted). No Reorganization is contingent upon any other Reorganization. Information has not been presented for any Reorganizations involving a Selling Fund the net assets of which were less than 10% of the net assets of the corresponding Buying Fund as of October 6, 2010.

Table 1 – Reorganizations

 

Selling Fund

  

Buying Fund

   Period Ended
Columbia Blended Equity Fund    Columbia Large Cap Core Fund    August 31, 2010
Columbia Select Opportunities Fund    Columbia Strategic Investor Fund    August 31, 2010
Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II    Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I    August 31, 2010
Columbia Disciplined Value Fund    Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund    September 30, 2010

Basis of Combination

In August 2010, the Boards of Trustees of the Selling Funds approved an Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “Plan of Reorganization”) pursuant to which, subject to shareholder approval, each Selling Fund will transfer all of its assets to the corresponding Buying Fund in exchange for shares of the corresponding Buying Fund (“Reorganization Shares”) and each Buying Fund will assume all of the liabilities of the corresponding Selling Fund. Selling Fund shareholders will receive the class of Reorganization Shares indicated in Table 2 below. Each Buying Fund will issue Reorganization Shares with an aggregate net asset value equal to the aggregate value of the assets that it receives from the corresponding Selling Fund, less the liabilities it assumes from the corresponding Selling Fund. All Reorganization Shares delivered to the Selling Funds will be delivered at net asset value without a sales load, commission or other similar fee being imposed. Immediately following the transfer, the Reorganization Shares received by each Selling Fund attributable to each class thereof will be distributed pro rata, on what is expected to be a tax-free basis for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to the shareholders of such class of the Selling Fund in proportion to their holdings of shares of the Selling Fund.

Table 2 – Reorganization Shares

 

Selling Fund Share Class

       

Reorganization Share Class

Class A

   ®    Class A

Class B

   ®    Class B

Class C

   ®    Class C

Class T

   ®    Class T

Class Z

   ®    Class Z

Under the terms of the Plan of Reorganization, each Reorganization will be accounted for by the method of accounting for tax-free mergers of investment companies. Following the Reorganizations, the Buying Funds will be the accounting survivors. In accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, the historical cost of investment securities will be carried forward to the surviving funds and the results of operations for pre-Reorganization periods will not be restated. The costs of the Reorganizations, current estimates of which are set

 

D-1


Table of Contents

forth in Table 5 below, will be borne by the Selling Funds and the Buying Funds (each a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”) up to the amount of the anticipated reduction in expenses borne by that Fund over the first year following the Reorganization. Any Reorganization expenses otherwise allocable to a Fund that are in excess of that limitation will be borne by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (“Columbia Management”) or its affiliates and not by any other Fund. If a Reorganization is not consummated, Columbia Management or its affiliates will bear the costs associated with that Reorganization. The pro forma information provided herein should be read in conjunction with the audited financial statements of the Funds included in their most recent annual reports and, as applicable, the unaudited financial statements of the Funds included in their most recent semi-annual reports, in each case dated as indicated in Table 3 below.

Table 3 – Shareholder Report Dates

 

Fund

   Annual Report    Semi-Annual
Report

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   2/28/2010    8/31/2010

Columbia Blended Equity Fund (Selling Fund)

   3/31/2010    9/30/2010

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

   8/31/2010    N/A

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

   3/31/2010    9/30/2010

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

   8/31/2010    N/A

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

   2/28/2010    8/31/2010

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

   9/30/2010    N/A

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   9/30/2010    N/A

Table 4 below presents, as of the date indicated, the net assets of each Fund.

Table 4 – Selling Funds and Buying Funds Net Assets

 

Fund

   Net Assets      As-Of Date

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 1,013,225,017       August 31, 2010

Columbia Blended Equity Fund. (Selling Fund)

   $ 119,657,863       August 31, 2010

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 711,969,399       August 31, 2010

Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 89,647,647       August 31, 2010

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

   $ 790,443,387       August 31, 2010

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

   $ 304,268,662       August 31, 2010

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

   $ 246,839,659       September 30, 2010

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   $ 207,829,423       September 30, 2010

Table 5 presents the estimated Reorganization costs (exclusive of any transaction costs associated with any portfolio realignment); the net assets as of the date indicated in Table 4 above of each Buying Fund assuming the indicated Reorganizations occurred on that date, after accounting for the estimated Reorganization costs to be borne by the Buying Fund and the corresponding Selling Fund; and, on a pro forma basis, the estimated relative increases or decreases in combined operating expenses that would have been incurred during the one-year period ended on the date indicated in Table 4 above. The pro forma increases and decreases represent the differences between (i) the combined expenses actually charged to the Buying Fund and the Selling Fund during the period and (ii) the expenses that would have been charged to the combined assets of the Buying and Selling Funds if the reorganizations and other contractual changes had occurred at the beginning of the year.

The unaudited pro forma information set forth in Table 5 below reflects adjustments made to expenses for differences in contractual rates, duplicate services and other services that would not have occurred if the

 

D-2


Table of Contents

Reorganizations had taken place on the first day of the period described in Table 1 above. The pro forma information has been derived from the books and records of the Funds utilized in calculating daily net asset value for the Funds and has been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, which require the use of management estimates. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Table 5 – Estimated Reorganization Costs, Combined Fund Net Assets and Pro Forma Increases or Decreases in Expenses (1)

 

Proposal 1

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

   $ 39,773   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

   $ 1,132,843,107   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (2)

   ($ 148,364

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 18,965

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 208,318

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 43,093

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 26,066

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 12,998

Transfer agency fees (3)

    $ 160,424   

Other (5)

   ($ 13,145
     (Increase) Decrease  

Waiver and/or reimbursement of fund expenses (6)

    $ 78,632   

 

Proposal 2

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

    $ 33,435   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

    $ 801,583,611   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (2)

   ($ 3,968

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 114,225

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 217,194

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 40,543

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 41,510

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 31,517

Transfer agency fees (3)

   ($ 2,740,970

Other (5)

   ($ 21,346
     (Increase) Decrease  

Waiver and/or reimbursement of fund expenses (6)

    $ 3,296,950   

 

Proposal 3

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

    $ 103,830   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

    $ 1,094,608,219   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (7)

    $ 41,037   

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 37,857

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 238,302

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 77,310

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 61,327

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 23,099

Transfer agency fees (3)

    $ 90,256   

Other (5)

   ($ 37,430

 

D-3


Table of Contents

 

Proposal 4

      

Estimated Reorganization Costs

    $ 78,539   

Combined Fund Net Assets as of the Date Indicated in Table 4

    $ 454,590,543   
     Increase (Decrease)  

Management fees (2)

    $ 80,689   

Custodian fees (3)

   ($ 16,025

Pricing and bookkeeping (4)

   ($ 79,963

Professional fees (5)

   ($ 58,086

Registration fees (5)

   ($ 58,800

Reports to shareholders (5)

   ($ 16,116

Transfer agency fees (3)

   ($ 129,611

Other (5)

   ($ 25,731
     (Increase) Decrease  

Waiver and/or reimbursement of fund expenses (6)

   $ (264,982

 

(1) See “Fees and Expenses” in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus for more information.
(2) Management fees are composed of an advisory fee and an administration fee and have been adjusted to reflect (i) the contractual rates charged to the Buying Fund and, as applicable (ii) the elimination of the performance incentive adjustment for the Buying Fund, proposed to be effective in the second quarter of 2011, subject to shareholder approval.
(3) Adjustment reflects changes in contractual rates.
(4) Adjustment reflects changes in contractual rates. This service will not be separately charged and will be provided as a component of administration services.
(5) Adjustment reflects the elimination of duplicate services.
(6) Adjustment reflects the aggregate (increase) decrease in expense reimbursements and/or waivers by Columbia Management and its affiliates.
(7) Management fees are composed of an advisory fee and an administration fee and have been adjusted to reflect the contractual rates charged to the Buying Fund, proposed to be effective in the second quarter of 2011.

Pursuant to an Investment Management Services Agreement with Columbia Management each Fund pays a monthly management fee to Columbia Management based on the average daily net assets of the Fund, at the annual rates shown in Table 6 below. The Board of Directors/Trustees of each Buying Fund has approved a new Investment Management Services Agreement (“New Agreement”) for each of the Buying Funds, under which management fees would be paid to Columbia Management based on the average daily net assets of the Fund, at the annual rates shown below.

For Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund, the New Agreement also reflects the elimination of a performance incentive adjustment (“PIA”). The PIA adjusts the investment management fee upward or downward monthly by measuring the percentage difference over a rolling 12-month period between the annualized performance of one Class A share of the Fund and the annualized performance of the Lipper Large-Cap Core Funds Index. The maximum adjustment is 0.12% per year. If the performance difference is less than 0.50%, the adjustment will be zero.

 

D-4


Table of Contents

 

The New Agreements for Columbia Large Cap Core Fund, Columbia Strategic Investor Fund and Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund are each subject to approval by shareholders of such Buying Fund.

Table 6 – Investment Management Fees

 

Fund

   Assets (billions)    Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Buying Fund -
Proposed)
 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.600

0.550

0.500

0.450

0.430

0.410


   

 

 

 

 

 

0.710

0.665

0.620

0.570

0.560

0.540


Columbia Blended Equity Fund. (Selling Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.750

0.570

0.520

0.470

0.450

0.430


    N/A   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.600

0.550

0.500

0.500

0.500

0.500


   

 

 

 

 

 

0.710

0.665

0.620

0.570

0.560

0.540


Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.750

0.570

0.520

0.470

0.450

0.430


    N/A   

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Over $1.0

    

 

 

0.870

0.820

0.770


   

 

 

0.790

0.745

0.700


Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Over $1.0

    

 

 

0.700

0.650

0.600


    N/A   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.0

Next $3.0

Next $1.5

Next $2.5

Next $5.0

Next $5.0

Next $4.0

Next $26.0

Over $50.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.600

0.600

0.575

0.575

0.550

0.525

0.500

0.485

0.470

0.450

0.425

0.400

0.375


   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.690

0.645

0.600

0.550

0.550

0.540

0.520

0.520

0.520

0.520

0.520

0.520

0.520


 

D-5


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Assets (billions)    Annual Rate at
Each  Asset Level
(Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset Level
(Buying Fund -
Proposed)
 

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $1.5

Next $3.0

Over $6.0

    

 

 

 

 

 

0.700

0.650

0.600

0.550

0.530

0.510


    N/A   

Pursuant to an Administrative Services Agreement with Columbia Management or Ameriprise Financial, Inc. (“Ameriprise Financial”), as indicated in Table 7 below, each Fund’s administrator (“Administrator”) provides most administrative services to the Fund. For all services provided under the Administrative Services Agreement, each Fund pays its Administrator a monthly administration fee as a percentage of the Fund’s average daily net assets, at the annual rates shown in Table 7 below. The Board of Directors/Trustees of each Buying Fund has approved a new Administrative Services Agreement for the Fund under which administration fees would be paid to Columbia Management based on the average daily net assets of the Fund, at the annual rates shown below.

Table 7 – Administration Fees

 

Fund

   Administrator    Assets (billions)    Annual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Buying
Fund - New)
 

Columbia Large Cap Core Fund (Buying Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.170

0.170

0.170

0.170

0.170


   

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


Columbia Blended Equity Fund. (Selling Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   All      0.150     N/A   

Columbia Strategic Investor Fund (Buying Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.150

0.150

0.125

0.125

0.125


   

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


Columbia Select Opportunities Fund (Selling Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   All      0.150     N/A   

 

D-6


Table of Contents

 

Fund

   Administrator    Assets (billions)    Annual Rate at
Each Asset
Level (Current)
    Annual Rate at
Each Asset

Level (Buying
Fund - New)
 

Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund I (Buying Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.000

0.000

0.000

0.000

0.000


   

 

 

 

 

0.080

0.075

0.070

0.060

0.050


Columbia Small Cap Growth Fund II (Selling Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   All      0.117     N/A   

Columbia Large Value Quantitative Fund (Buying Fund)

   Ameriprise
Financial
   First $0.5

Next $0.5

Next $2.0

Next $9.0

Over $12.0

    

 

 

 

 

0.060

0.055

0.050

0.040

0.030


    Same as Current   

Columbia Disciplined Value Fund (Selling Fund)

   Columbia
Management
   All      0.067     N/A   

Ameriprise Financial provides accounting services as part of its Administrative Services Agreement. State Street Bank and Trust Company provides accounting services to the Funds administered by Columbia Management.

Columbia Management Investment Services Corp., an affiliate of Columbia Management, is the transfer agent for each Fund. Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc., an affiliate of Columbia Management, is the distributor for each Fund.

No significant accounting policies will change as the result of the proposed Reorganizations.

The estimated costs of the Reorganizations shown in Table 5 above do not reflect any brokerage commissions incurred by a Fund in connection with any portfolio realignment. Columbia Management expects that, subsequent to the Reorganizations, there may be some portfolio realignment of the Buying Funds (of securities acquired from the Selling Funds). However, Columbia Management expects that any such portfolio realignment will not result in any significant increase in a Buying Fund’s portfolio turnover rate, relative to its historical portfolio turnover rates. Columbia Management also does not expect any incremental trading costs to be significant.

Federal Income Taxes

Please see “Tax Status of the Reorganizations” in the Prospectus/Proxy Statement for a discussion of the tax effects of each Reorganization.

It is each Fund’s policy to comply with the requirements of the Internal Revenue Code applicable to regulated investment companies, and to distribute all of its investment company taxable income to shareholders. After the Reorganizations, the Buying Funds intend to continue to qualify as regulated investment companies.

 

D-7


Table of Contents

 

COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST

PART C

OTHER INFORMATION

PART C. OTHER INFORMATION

 

Item 15. Indemnification

Article VII of the Registrant’s Declaration of Trust provides for the indemnification of the Registrant’s trustees, officers, employees and other agents. Indemnification of the Registrant’s administrators, distributor, custodian and transfer agents is provided for, respectively, in the Registrant’s:

 

  1. Administrative Services Agreement with CMIA;

 

  2. Distribution Agreement with CMID;

 

  3. Custody Agreement with State Street; and

 

  4. Transfer Agency and Services Agreement with CMIS and CMIA.

THE REGISTRANT HAS ENTERED INTO A CROSS INDEMNIFICATION AGREEMENT WITH THE MASTER TRUST DATED SEPTEMBER 26, 2005. THE MASTER TRUST WILL INDEMNIFY AND HOLD HARMLESS THE TRUST AGAINST ANY LOSSES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES OR LIABILITIES TO WHICH THE TRUST MAY BECOME SUBJECT UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 (THE 1933 ACT), THE INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT OF 1940 (THE 1940 ACT), OR OTHERWISE, INSOFAR AS SUCH LOSSES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES OR LIABILITIES (OR ACTIONS IN RESPECT THEREOF) ARISE OUT OF OR ARE BASED UPON AN UNTRUE STATEMENT OR ALLEGED UNTRUE STATEMENT OF A MATERIAL FACT CONTAINED IN ANY PROSPECTUSES, ANY PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUSES, THE REGISTRATION STATEMENTS, ANY OTHER PROSPECTUSES RELATING TO THE SECURITIES, OR ANY AMENDMENTS OR SUPPLEMENTS TO THE FOREGOING (HEREINAFTER REFERRED TO COLLECTIVELY AS THE “OFFERING DOCUMENTS”), OR ARISE OUT OF OR ARE BASED UPON THE OMISSION OR ALLEGED OMISSION TO STATE THEREIN A MATERIAL FACT REQUIRED TO BE STATED OR NECESSARY TO MAKE THE STATEMENTS THEREIN NOT MISLEADING, IN EACH CASE TO THE EXTENT, BUT ONLY TO THE EXTENT, THAT SUCH UNTRUE STATEMENT OR ALLEGED UNTRUE STATEMENT OR OMISSION OR ALLEGED OMISSION WAS MADE IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS IN RELIANCE UPON AND IN CONFORMITY WITH WRITTEN INFORMATION FURNISHED TO THE TRUST BY THE MASTER TRUST EXPRESSLY FOR USE THEREIN; AND WILL REIMBURSE THE TRUST FOR ANY LEGAL OR OTHER EXPENSES REASONABLY INCURRED BY THE TRUST IN CONNECTION WITH INVESTIGATING OR DEFENDING ANY SUCH ACTION OR CLAIM; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, THAT THE MASTER TRUST SHALL NOT BE LIABLE IN ANY SUCH CASE TO THE EXTENT THAT ANY SUCH LOSS, CLAIM, DAMAGE, OR LIABILITY ARISES OUT OF OR IS BASED UPON AN UNTRUE STATEMENT OR ALLEGED UNTRUE STATEMENT OR OMISSION OR ALLEGED OMISSION MADE IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS IN RELIANCE UPON AND IN CONFORMITY WITH WRITTEN INFORMATION FURNISHED TO THE MASTER TRUST BY THE TRUST FOR USE IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS.

THE TRUST WILL INDEMNIFY AND HOLD HARMLESS THE MASTER TRUST AGAINST ANY LOSSES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES OR LIABILITIES TO WHICH THE MASTER TRUST MAY BECOME SUBJECT UNDER THE 1933 ACT, THE 1940 ACT, OR OTHERWISE, INSOFAR AS SUCH LOSSES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES OR LIABILITIES (OR ACTIONS IN RESPECT THEREOF) ARISE OUT OF OR ARE BASED UPON AN UNTRUE STATEMENT OR ALLEGED UNTRUE STATEMENT OF A MATERIAL FACT CONTAINED IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS OR ARISE OUT OF OR ARE BASED UPON THE OMISSION OR ALLEGED OMISSION TO STATE THEREIN A MATERIAL FACT REQUIRED TO BE STATED OR NECESSARY TO MAKE THE STATEMENTS THEREIN NOT MISLEADING, IN EACH CASE TO THE EXTENT, BUT ONLY TO THE EXTENT, THAT SUCH UNTRUE STATEMENT OR ALLEGED UNTRUE STATEMENT OR OMISSION OR ALLEGED OMISSION WAS MADE IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS IN RELIANCE UPON AND IN


Table of Contents

CONFORMITY WITH WRITTEN INFORMATION FURNISHED TO THE MASTER TRUST BY THE TRUST EXPRESSLY FOR USE THEREIN; AND WILL REIMBURSE THE MASTER TRUST FOR ANY LEGAL OR OTHER EXPENSES REASONABLY INCURRED BY THE MASTER TRUST IN CONNECTION WITH INVESTIGATING OR DEFENDING ANY SUCH ACTION OR CLAIM; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, THAT THE TRUST SHALL NOT BE LIABLE IN ANY SUCH CASE TO THE EXTENT THAT ANY SUCH LOSS, CLAIM, DAMAGE, OR LIABILITY ARISES OUT OF OR IS BASED UPON AN UNTRUE STATEMENT OR ALLEGED UNTRUE STATEMENT OR OMISSION OR ALLEGED OMISSION MADE IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS IN RELIANCE UPON AND IN CONFORMITY WITH WRITTEN INFORMATION FURNISHED TO THE TRUST BY THE MASTER TRUST FOR USE IN THE OFFERING DOCUMENTS.

PROMPTLY AFTER RECEIPT BY AN INDEMNIFIED PARTY UNDER SUBSECTION (A) OR (B) ABOVE OF NOTICE OF THE COMMENCEMENT OF ANY ACTION, SUCH INDEMNIFIED PARTY SHALL, IF A CLAIM IN RESPECT THEREOF IS TO BE MADE AGAINST AN INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES UNDER SUCH SUBSECTION, NOTIFY THE INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES IN WRITING OF THE COMMENCEMENT THEREOF; BUT THE OMISSION TO SO NOTIFY THE INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES SHALL NOT RELIEVE IT OR THEM FROM ANY LIABILITY WHICH IT OR THEY MAY HAVE TO ANY INDEMNIFIED PARTY OTHERWISE THAN UNDER SUCH SUBSECTION. IN CASE ANY SUCH ACTION SHALL BE BROUGHT AGAINST ANY INDEMNIFIED PARTY AND IT SHALL NOTIFY THE INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES OF THE COMMENCEMENT THEREOF, THE INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES SHALL BE ENTITLED TO PARTICIPATE THEREIN AND, TO THE EXTENT THAT EITHER INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR BOTH SHALL WISH, TO ASSUME THE DEFENSE THEREOF, WITH COUNSEL SATISFACTORY TO SUCH INDEMNIFIED PARTY, AND, AFTER NOTICE FROM THE INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES TO SUCH INDEMNIFIED PART OF ITS OR THEIR ELECTION SO TO ASSUME THE DEFENSE THEREOF, THE INDEMNIFYING PARTY OR PARTIES SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO SUCH INDEMNIFIED PARTY UNDER SUCH SUBSECTION FOR ANY LEGAL EXPENSES OF OTHER COUNSEL OR ANY OTHER EXPENSES, IN EACH CASE SUBSEQUENTLY INCURRED BY SUCH INDEMNIFIED PARTY, IN CONNECTION WITH THE DEFENSE THEREOF OTHER THAN REASONABLE COSTS OF INVESTIGATION.

THE REGISTRANT HAS OBTAINED FROM A MAJOR INSURANCE CARRIER A TRUSTEES’ AND OFFICERS’ LIABILITY POLICY COVERING CERTAIN TYPES OF ERRORS AND OMISSIONS. IN NO EVENT WILL THE REGISTRANT INDEMNIFY ANY OF ITS TRUSTEES, OFFICERS, EMPLOYEES, OR AGENTS AGAINST ANY LIABILITY TO WHICH SUCH PERSON WOULD OTHERWISE BE SUBJECT BY REASON OF HIS/HER WILLFUL MISFEASANCE, BAD FAITH, GROSS NEGLIGENCE IN THE PERFORMANCE OF HIS/HER DUTIES, OR BY REASON OF HIS/HER RECKLESS DISREGARD OF THE DUTIES INVOLVED IN THE CONDUCT OF HIS/HER OFFICE OR ARISING UNDER HIS AGREEMENT WITH THE REGISTRANT. THE REGISTRANT WILL COMPLY WITH RULE 484 UNDER THE 1933 ACT AND RELEASE NO. 11330 UNDER THE 1940 ACT, IN CONNECTION WITH ANY INDEMNIFICATION.

INSOFAR AS INDEMNIFICATION FOR LIABILITY ARISING UNDER THE 1933 ACT MAY BE PERMITTED TO TRUSTEES, OFFICERS, AND CONTROLLING PERSONS OF THE REGISTRANT PURSUANT TO THE FOREGOING PROVISIONS, OR OTHERWISE, THE REGISTRANT HAS BEEN ADVISED THAT IN THE OPINION OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION (SEC) SUCH INDEMNIFICATION IS AGAINST PUBLIC POLICY AS EXPRESSED IN THE 1933 ACT AND IS, THEREFORE, UNENFORCEABLE. IN THE EVENT THAT A CLAIM FOR INDEMNIFICATION AGAINST SUCH LIABILITIES (OTHER THAN THE PAYMENT BY THE REGISTRANT OF EXPENSES INCURRED OR PAID BY A TRUSTEE, OFFICER, OR CONTROLLING PERSON OF THE REGISTRANT IN THE SUCCESSFUL DEFENSE OF ANY ACTION, SUIT, OR PROCEEDING) IS ASSERTED BY SUCH TRUSTEE, OFFICER OR CONTROLLING PERSON IN CONNECTION WITH THE SECURITIES BEING REGISTERED, THE REGISTRANT WILL, UNLESS IN THE OPINION OF ITS COUNSEL THE MATTER HAS BEEN SETTLED BY CONTROLLING PRECEDENT, SUBMIT TO A COURT OF APPROPRIATE JURISDICTION THE QUESTION WHETHER SUCH INDEMNIFICATION BY IT IS AGAINST PUBLIC POLICY AS EXPRESSED IN THE 1933 ACT AND WILL BE GOVERNED BY THE FINAL ADJUDICATION OF SUCH ISSUE.


Table of Contents

 

Item 16. Exhibits

All references to the “Registration Statement” in the following list of Exhibits refer to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form N-1A (File Nos. 333-89661; 811-09645), unless otherwise noted.

 

(1) (a) Certificate of Trust dated October 22, 1999 is incorporated by reference to Post-Effective Amendment (“PEA”) No. 1 to the Registration Statement filed on February 10, 2000.

 

(1) (b) Certificate of Amendment of Certificate of Trust dated September 21, 2005 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 41 to the Registration Statement filed on November 21, 2005.

 

(1) (c) Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust dated September 26, 2005 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 41 to the Registration Statement filed on November 21, 2005.

 

(2) Not applicable.

 

(3) Not applicable.

 

(4) Form of Agreement and Plan of Reorganization is filed electronically herewith.

 

(5) Articles III and VII of Registrant’s Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust dated September 26, 2005 define the rights of holders of securities being registered.

 

(6) (a) Investment Management Services Agreement between Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC (“CMIA”) and the Registrant is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(6) (b) Assumption Agreement by CMIA for Columbia Funds Series Trust (“CFST”) on behalf of Columbia LifeGoal Growth Portfolio, Columbia LifeGoal Balanced Growth Portfolio and Columbia LifeGoal Income and Growth Portfolio is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(6) (c) Assumption Agreement by CMIA for CFST on behalf of Corporate Bond Portfolio and Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Portfolio is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(6) (d) Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement among CMIA, Brandes Investment Partners, L.P. (“Brandes”) and the Registrant is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(6) (e) Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement among CMIA, Marsico Capital Management, LLC (“Marsico”) and the Registrant is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(6) (f) Investment Sub-Advisory Agreement among CMIA, MacKay Shields LLC (“MacKay Shields”) and the Registrant is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(7) Distribution Agreement with Columbia Management Investment Distributors, Inc. (“CMID”), the Registrant and Columbia Funds Series Trust II is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.


Table of Contents
(8) Form of Deferred Compensation Plan incorporated by reference to PEA No. 7 to the Registration Statement of Columbia Funds Series Trust II, File Nos. 333-132211 and 811-21862, filed February 26, 2010.

 

(9) (a) Master Custodian Agreement between the Registrant and State Street Bank and Trust Company (“State Street”) dated June 13, 2005, with Appendix A dated May 5, 2008, is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 67 to the Registration Statement filed on June 27, 2008.

 

(9) (b) Amendment No. 1 to the Master Custodian Agreement between the Registrant and State Street dated June 1, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 45 to the Registration Statement filed on June 14, 2006.

 

(10) (a) Shareholder Servicing and Distribution Plan for Registrant’s Class A Shares with Exhibit I dated April 30, 2008 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 68 to the Registration Statement filed on July 29, 2008.

 

(10) (b) Distribution Plan for certain Fund share classes of the Registrant is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.

 

(10) (c) Shareholder Servicing Plan for certain Fund share classes of Registrant is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.

 

(10) (d)(i) Shareholder Servicing Plan Implementation Agreement between Registrant and CMID is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(10) (d)(ii) Restated Schedule I to Shareholder Servicing Plan Implementation Agreement, dated September 7, 2010, is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.

 

(10) (e) Amended and Restated Rule 18f-3 Multi-Class Plan is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.

 

(11) Opinion and consent of counsel as to the legality of the securities being registered is filed electronically herewith.

 

(12) Opinion of Counsel – to be filed by amendment.

 

(13) (a) Administrative Services Agreement between the Registrant and CMIA is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(13) (b) Transfer and Dividend Disbursing Agent Agreement among Columbia Management Investment Services Corp. (“CMIS”), the Registrant, Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC, and Columbia Funds Series Trust II, dated September 7, 2010, is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.

 

(13) (c) Plan Administration Services Agreement among CMIS, the Registrant and Columbia Funds Series Trust I, dated September 7, 2010, relating to Class R4 shares is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 88 to the Registration Statement filed on September 27, 2010.

 

(13) (d) Cross Indemnification Agreement between Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC and the Registrant dated September 26, 2005 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 45 to the Registration Statement filed on June 14, 2006.

 

(13) (e) Mutual Fund Fee and Expense Agreement among the Registrant, Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC, Columbia Funds Variable Insurance Trust I, Columbia Funds Series Trust II, CMIA and CMID is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.


Table of Contents
(13) (f)(i) Financial Reporting Services Agreement among the Registrant, the other parties listed on Schedule A, CMA and State Street dated December 15, 2006, with Schedule A dated May 5, 2008, is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 67 to the Registration Statement filed on June 27, 2008.

 

(13) (f)(ii) Amendment to Financial Reporting Services dated April 30, 2010 with Schedule A dated May 1, 2010 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(13) (g)(i) Accounting Services Agreement among the Registrant, the other parties listed on Schedule A, CMA and State Street dated December 15, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 67 to the Registration Statement filed on June 27, 2008.

 

(13) (g)(ii) Amendment to Accounting Services Agreement dated April 30, 2010, with Schedule A dated May 1, 2010, is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(13) (h)(i) Committed Line of Credit Agreement among the Registrant, the other parties listed on Schedule 2, the lending institutions listed on the signature pages and State Street dated October 19, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (h)(ii) Notice and Acknowledgement to Committed Line of Credit Agreement regarding conversion of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust, LLC (formerly, Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust) to a Delaware limited liability company, dated March 30, 2007, to be filed by amendment to the Registration Statement.

 

(13) (h)(iii) Amendment Agreement No. 1 and Instrument of Adherence dated October 18, 2007 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (h)(iv) Amendment Agreement No. 2 dated as of February 28, 2008 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 63 filed on March 28, 2008.

 

(13) (h)(v) Amendment Agreement No. 3 dated as of March 31, 2008 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 64 to the Registration Statement filed on April 28, 2008.

 

(13) (h)(vi) Amendment Agreement No. 4 dated October 16, 2008 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 70 to the Registration Statement filed on or about December 23, 2008.

 

(13) (h)(vii) Amendment No. 5 to Committed Credit Agreement dated June 1, 2009 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 7 to the Registration Statement of Columbia Funds Series Trust II, File Nos. 333-132211 and 811-21862, filed February 26, 2010.

 

(13) (h)(viii) Amendment No. 6 to Committed Credit Agreement dated October 15, 2009 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 7 to the Registration Statement of Columbia Funds Series Trust II, File Nos. 333-132211 and 811-21862, filed February 26, 2010.

 

(13) (i)(i) Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement among the Registrant, the other parties listed on Appendix 1 and State Street dated September 19, 2005 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (i)(ii) Amendment No. 1 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated February 15, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (i)(iii) Amendment No. 2 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated June 7, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (i)(iv) Amendment No. 3 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated September 15, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.


Table of Contents

 

(13) (i)(v) Amendment No. 4 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated October 19, 2006 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (i)(vi) Amendment No. 5 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement September 17, 2007 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (i)(vii) Amendment No. 6 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated October 18, 2007 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 55 to the Registration Statement filed on December 14, 2007.

 

(13) (i)(viii) Notice and Acknowledgement to Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement regarding conversion of Columbia Funds Master Investment Trust LLC to a Delaware limited liability company dated March 30, 2007, to be filed by amendment to the Registration Statement.

 

(13) (i)(ix) Amendment No. 7 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated as of February 28, 2008 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 63 to the Registration Statement filed on March 28, 2008.

 

(13) (i)(x) Amendment No. 8 to the Uncommitted Line of Credit Agreement dated as of March 31, 2008 is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 64 to the Registration Statement filed on April 28, 2008.

 

(13) (j) Securities Lending Authorization Agreement, to be filed by amendment to the Registration Statement.

 

(13) (k)(1) Columbia Funds Family Code of Ethics, effective January 3, 2006, is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 56 to the Registration Statement filed on December 31, 2007.

 

(13) (k)(2) Brandes Code of Ethics is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 67 to the Registration Statement filed on June 27, 2008.

 

(13) (k)(3) Marsico Code of Ethics is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 73 to the Registration Statement filed on or about June 26, 2009.

 

(13) (k)(4) MacKay Shields Code of Ethics is incorporated by reference to PEA No. 82 to the Registration Statement filed on May 28, 2010.

 

(14) (a) Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (Ernst & Young LLP) is filed electronically herewith.

 

(14) (b) Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (Ernst & Young LLP) is filed electronically herewith.

 

(14) (c) Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP) is filed electronically herewith.

 

(14) (d) Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP) is filed electronically herewith.

 

(15) Not applicable.

 

(16) Trustees Power of Attorney to sign Amendments to this Registration Statement is filed electronically herewith.

 

(17) Not applicable.

 

Item 17. Undertakings

 

(1) The undersigned registrant agrees that prior to any public reoffering of the securities registered through the use of a prospectus which is a part of this registration statement by any person or party who is deemed to be an underwriter within the meaning of Rule 145(c) of the Securities Act, the reoffering prospectus will contain the information called for by the applicable registration form for reofferings by persons who may be deemed underwriters, in addition to the information called for by the other items of the applicable form.


Table of Contents

 

(2) The undersigned registrant agrees that every prospectus that is filed under paragraph (1) above will be filed as a part of an amendment to the registration statement and will not be used until the amendment is effective, and that, in determining any liability under the 1933 Act, each post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement for the securities offered therein, and the offering of the securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering of them.

 

(3) The Registrant undertakes to file the opinion of counsel supporting the tax consequences of the proposed reorganization required by Item 16(12) through an amendment to this Registration Statement no later than a reasonable time after the closing of the transaction.


Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURES

As required by the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement has been signed on behalf of the Registrant by the undersigned, duly authorized, in the City of Minneapolis, and The State of Minnesota on the 29th day of October, 2010.

 

COLUMBIA FUNDS SERIES TRUST
By:  

/S/    J. KEVIN CONNAUGHTON        

Name:

 

J. Kevin Connaughton

Title:   President

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the date indicated:

 

SIGNATURES

  

TITLE

 

DATE

/S/    J. KEVIN CONNAUGHTON        

J. Kevin Connaughton

  

President

(Principal Executive Officer)

  October 29, 2010

/S/    MICHAEL G. CLARKE        

Michael G. Clarke

  

Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial Officer)

  October 29, 2010

/S/    JOSEPH F. DIMARIA        

Joseph F. DiMaria

  

Chief Accounting Officer

(Principal Accounting Officer)

  October 29, 2010

/S/    EDWARD J. BOUDREAU, JR.*        

Edward J. Boudreau, Jr.

   Trustee   October 29, 2010

/S/    WILLIAM P. CARMICHAEL*        

William P. Carmichael

   Trustee   October 29, 2010

/S/    WILLIAM A HAWKINS*        

William A. Hawkins

   Trustee   October 29, 2010

/S/    R. GLENN HILLIARD*        

R. Glenn Hilliard

   Trustee   October 29, 2010

/S/    MINOR M. SHAW*        

Minor M. Shaw

   Trustee   October 29, 2010

/S/    JOHN J. NAGORNIAK*        

John J. Nagorniak

   Trustee   October 29, 2010

/S/    ANTHONY M. SANTOMERO*        

Anthony M. Santomero

   Trustee   October 29, 2010


Table of Contents

 

*By:  

/S/    RYAN C. LARRENAGA        

 

Ryan C. Larrenaga**

Attorney-in-Fact

October 29, 2010

 

** Executed by Ryan C. Larrenaga on behalf of each of the Trustees pursuant to a Power of Attorney filed herewith.


Table of Contents

 

Exhibit Index

 

Exhibit

No.

 

Description

(4)   Form of Agreement and Plan of Reorganization
(11)   Opinion and consent of counsel as to the legality of the securities being registered
(14)(a)  

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (Ernst & Young LLP)

(14)(b)   Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (Ernst & Young LLP)
(14)(c)
 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP)

(14)(d)  

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP)

(16)   Trustees Power of Attorney to sign Amendments to this Registration Statement